diff options
Diffstat (limited to 'lib/lufa')
1456 files changed, 394635 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/lib/lufa/.gitattributes b/lib/lufa/.gitattributes new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..92dfc3c617 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/.gitattributes @@ -0,0 +1,94 @@ +# auto for anything unspecified +* text=auto + +# sources +*.c text +*.cc text +*.cxx text +*.cpp text +*.c++ text +*.hpp text +*.h text +*.h++ text +*.hh text +*.bat text +*.coffee text +*.css text +*.htm text +*.html text +*.inc text +*.ini text +*.js text +*.jsx text +*.json text +*.less text +*.php text +*.pl text +*.py text +*.rb text +*.sass text +*.scm text +*.scss text +*.sh text +*.sql text +*.styl text +*.ts text +*.xml text +*.xhtml text + +# make files (need to always use lf for compatibility with Windows 10 bash) +Makefile eol=lf +*.mk eol=lf + +# make files (need to always use lf for compatibility with Windows 10 bash) +*.sh eol=lf + +# documentation +*.markdown text +*.md text +*.mdwn text +*.mdown text +*.mkd text +*.mkdn text +*.mdtxt text +*.mdtext text +*.txt text +AUTHORS text +CHANGELOG text +CHANGES text +CONTRIBUTING text +COPYING text +INSTALL text +license text +LICENSE text +NEWS text +readme text +*README* text +TODO text + +GRAPHICS +*.ai binary +*.bmp binary +*.eps binary +*.gif binary +*.ico binary +*.jng binary +*.jp2 binary +*.jpg binary +*.jpeg binary +*.jpx binary +*.jxr binary +*.pdf binary +*.png binary +*.psb binary +*.psd binary +*.svg text +*.svgz binary +*.tif binary +*.tiff binary +*.wbmp binary +*.webp binary + +# hex files +*.hex binary +*.eep binary diff --git a/lib/lufa/.gitignore b/lib/lufa/.gitignore new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9f9d39491d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/.gitignore @@ -0,0 +1,15 @@ +*.o +*.d +*.elf +*.hex +*.eep +*.sym +*.bin +*.lss +*.map +*.bak +*.class +Documentation/ +LUFA/StudioIntegration/ProjectGenerator/* +LUFA/StudioIntegration/DocBook/* +!LUFA/StudioIntegration/Docbook/mshelp/* diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderAPI.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderAPI.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2be1568082 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderAPI.c @@ -0,0 +1,75 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Bootloader user application API functions. + */ + +#include "BootloaderAPI.h" + +void BootloaderAPI_ErasePage(const uint32_t Address) +{ + boot_page_erase_safe(Address); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + boot_rww_enable(); +} + +void BootloaderAPI_WritePage(const uint32_t Address) +{ + boot_page_write_safe(Address); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + boot_rww_enable(); +} + +void BootloaderAPI_FillWord(const uint32_t Address, const uint16_t Word) +{ + boot_page_fill_safe(Address, Word); +} + +uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature(const uint16_t Address) +{ + return boot_signature_byte_get(Address); +} + +uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse(const uint16_t Address) +{ + return boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(Address); +} + +uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadLock(void) +{ + return boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_LOCK_BITS); +} + +void BootloaderAPI_WriteLock(const uint8_t LockBits) +{ + boot_lock_bits_set_safe(LockBits); +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderAPI.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderAPI.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5169bbc3c4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderAPI.h @@ -0,0 +1,58 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for BootloaderAPI.c. + */ + +#ifndef _BOOTLOADER_API_H_ +#define _BOOTLOADER_API_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/boot.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void BootloaderAPI_ErasePage(const uint32_t Address); + void BootloaderAPI_WritePage(const uint32_t Address); + void BootloaderAPI_FillWord(const uint32_t Address, const uint16_t Word); + uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature(const uint16_t Address); + uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse(const uint16_t Address); + uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadLock(void); + void BootloaderAPI_WriteLock(const uint8_t LockBits); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderAPITable.S b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderAPITable.S new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2c60f84e8d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderAPITable.S @@ -0,0 +1,91 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +; Trampolines to actual API implementations if the target address is outside the +; range of a rjmp instruction (can happen with large bootloader sections) +.section .apitable_trampolines, "ax" +.global BootloaderAPI_Trampolines +BootloaderAPI_Trampolines: + + BootloaderAPI_ErasePage_Trampoline: + jmp BootloaderAPI_ErasePage + BootloaderAPI_WritePage_Trampoline: + jmp BootloaderAPI_WritePage + BootloaderAPI_FillWord_Trampoline: + jmp BootloaderAPI_FillWord + BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature_Trampoline: + jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature + BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse_Trampoline: + jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse + BootloaderAPI_ReadLock_Trampoline: + jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadLock + BootloaderAPI_WriteLock_Trampoline: + jmp BootloaderAPI_WriteLock + BootloaderAPI_UNUSED1: + ret + BootloaderAPI_UNUSED2: + ret + BootloaderAPI_UNUSED3: + ret + BootloaderAPI_UNUSED4: + ret + BootloaderAPI_UNUSED5: + ret + + + +; API function jump table +.section .apitable_jumptable, "ax" +.global BootloaderAPI_JumpTable +BootloaderAPI_JumpTable: + + rjmp BootloaderAPI_ErasePage_Trampoline + rjmp BootloaderAPI_WritePage_Trampoline + rjmp BootloaderAPI_FillWord_Trampoline + rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature_Trampoline + rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse_Trampoline + rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadLock_Trampoline + rjmp BootloaderAPI_WriteLock_Trampoline + rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED1 ; UNUSED ENTRY 1 + rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED2 ; UNUSED ENTRY 2 + rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED3 ; UNUSED ENTRY 3 + rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED4 ; UNUSED ENTRY 4 + rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED5 ; UNUSED ENTRY 5 + + + +; Bootloader table signatures and information +.section .apitable_signatures, "ax" +.global BootloaderAPI_Signatures +BootloaderAPI_Signatures: + + .long BOOT_START_ADDR ; Start address of the bootloader + .word 0xDF00 ; Signature for the CDC class bootloader + .word 0xDCFB ; Signature for a LUFA class bootloader diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..aa17bc15bd --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.c @@ -0,0 +1,673 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the CDC class bootloader. This file contains the complete bootloader logic. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADERCDC_C +#include "BootloaderCDC.h" + +/** Contains the current baud rate and other settings of the first virtual serial port. This must be retained as some + * operating systems will not open the port unless the settings can be set successfully. + */ +static CDC_LineEncoding_t LineEncoding = { .BaudRateBPS = 0, + .CharFormat = CDC_LINEENCODING_OneStopBit, + .ParityType = CDC_PARITY_None, + .DataBits = 8 }; + +/** Current address counter. This stores the current address of the FLASH or EEPROM as set by the host, + * and is used when reading or writing to the AVRs memory (either FLASH or EEPROM depending on the issued + * command.) + */ +static uint32_t CurrAddress; + +/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader should be running, or should exit and allow the application code to run + * via a watchdog reset. When cleared the bootloader will exit, starting the watchdog and entering an infinite + * loop until the AVR restarts and the application runs. + */ +static bool RunBootloader = true; + +/** Magic lock for forced application start. If the HWBE fuse is programmed and BOOTRST is unprogrammed, the bootloader + * will start if the /HWB line of the AVR is held low and the system is reset. However, if the /HWB line is still held + * low when the application attempts to start via a watchdog reset, the bootloader will re-start. If set to the value + * \ref MAGIC_BOOT_KEY the special init function \ref Application_Jump_Check() will force the application to start. + */ +uint16_t MagicBootKey ATTR_NO_INIT; + + +/** Special startup routine to check if the bootloader was started via a watchdog reset, and if the magic application + * start key has been loaded into \ref MagicBootKey. If the bootloader started via the watchdog and the key is valid, + * this will force the user application to start via a software jump. + */ +void Application_Jump_Check(void) +{ + bool JumpToApplication = false; + + #if (BOARD == BOARD_LEONARDO) + /* Enable pull-up on the IO13 pin so we can use it to select the mode */ + PORTC |= (1 << 7); + Delay_MS(10); + + /* If IO13 is not jumpered to ground, start the user application instead */ + JumpToApplication = ((PINC & (1 << 7)) != 0); + + /* Disable pull-up after the check has completed */ + PORTC &= ~(1 << 7); + #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + /* Disable JTAG debugging */ + JTAG_DISABLE(); + + /* Enable pull-up on the JTAG TCK pin so we can use it to select the mode */ + PORTF |= (1 << 4); + Delay_MS(10); + + /* If the TCK pin is not jumpered to ground, start the user application instead */ + JumpToApplication = ((PINF & (1 << 4)) != 0); + + /* Re-enable JTAG debugging */ + JTAG_ENABLE(); + #else + /* Check if the device's BOOTRST fuse is set */ + if (boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_HIGH_FUSE_BITS) & FUSE_BOOTRST) + { + /* If the reset source was not an external reset or the key is correct, clear it and jump to the application */ + if (!(MCUSR & (1 << EXTRF)) || (MagicBootKey == MAGIC_BOOT_KEY)) + JumpToApplication = true; + + /* Clear reset source */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << EXTRF); + } + else + { + /* If the reset source was the bootloader and the key is correct, clear it and jump to the application; + * this can happen in the HWBE fuse is set, and the HBE pin is low during the watchdog reset */ + if ((MCUSR & (1 << WDRF)) && (MagicBootKey == MAGIC_BOOT_KEY)) + JumpToApplication = true; + + /* Clear reset source */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + } + #endif + + /* Don't run the user application if the reset vector is blank (no app loaded) */ + bool ApplicationValid = (pgm_read_word_near(0) != 0xFFFF); + + /* If a request has been made to jump to the user application, honor it */ + if (JumpToApplication && ApplicationValid) + { + /* Turn off the watchdog */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Clear the boot key and jump to the user application */ + MagicBootKey = 0; + + // cppcheck-suppress constStatement + ((void (*)(void))0x0000)(); + } +} + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the bootloader, then continuously + * runs the bootloader processing routine until instructed to soft-exit, or hard-reset via the watchdog to start + * the loaded application code. + */ +int main(void) +{ + /* Setup hardware required for the bootloader */ + SetupHardware(); + + /* Turn on first LED on the board to indicate that the bootloader has started */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDS_LED1); + + /* Enable global interrupts so that the USB stack can function */ + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + while (RunBootloader) + { + CDC_Task(); + USB_USBTask(); + } + + /* Wait a short time to end all USB transactions and then disconnect */ + _delay_us(1000); + + /* Disconnect from the host - USB interface will be reset later along with the AVR */ + USB_Detach(); + + /* Unlock the forced application start mode of the bootloader if it is restarted */ + MagicBootKey = MAGIC_BOOT_KEY; + + /* Enable the watchdog and force a timeout to reset the AVR */ + wdt_enable(WDTO_250MS); + + for (;;); +} + +/** Configures all hardware required for the bootloader. */ +static void SetupHardware(void) +{ + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); + + /* Relocate the interrupt vector table to the bootloader section */ + MCUCR = (1 << IVCE); + MCUCR = (1 << IVSEL); + + /* Initialize the USB and other board hardware drivers */ + USB_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + + /* Bootloader active LED toggle timer initialization */ + TIMSK1 = (1 << TOIE1); + TCCR1B = ((1 << CS11) | (1 << CS10)); +} + +/** ISR to periodically toggle the LEDs on the board to indicate that the bootloader is active. */ +ISR(TIMER1_OVF_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This configures the device's endpoints ready + * to relay data to and from the attached USB host. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + /* Setup CDC Notification, Rx and Tx Endpoints */ + Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, + CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, 1); + + Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, 1); + + Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, 1); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to + * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing + * internally. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + /* Ignore any requests that aren't directed to the CDC interface */ + if ((USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType & (CONTROL_REQTYPE_TYPE | CONTROL_REQTYPE_RECIPIENT)) != + (REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + return; + } + + /* Activity - toggle indicator LEDs */ + LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2); + + /* Process CDC specific control requests */ + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case CDC_REQ_GetLineEncoding: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Write the line coding data to the control endpoint */ + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(&LineEncoding, sizeof(CDC_LineEncoding_t)); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + + break; + case CDC_REQ_SetLineEncoding: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Read the line coding data in from the host into the global struct */ + Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE(&LineEncoding, sizeof(CDC_LineEncoding_t)); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } + + break; + case CDC_REQ_SetControlLineState: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + } +} + +#if !defined(NO_BLOCK_SUPPORT) +/** Reads or writes a block of EEPROM or FLASH memory to or from the appropriate CDC data endpoint, depending + * on the AVR109 protocol command issued. + * + * \param[in] Command Single character AVR109 protocol command indicating what memory operation to perform + */ +static void ReadWriteMemoryBlock(const uint8_t Command) +{ + uint16_t BlockSize; + char MemoryType; + + uint8_t HighByte = 0; + uint8_t LowByte = 0; + + BlockSize = (FetchNextCommandByte() << 8); + BlockSize |= FetchNextCommandByte(); + + MemoryType = FetchNextCommandByte(); + + if ((MemoryType != MEMORY_TYPE_FLASH) && (MemoryType != MEMORY_TYPE_EEPROM)) + { + /* Send error byte back to the host */ + WriteNextResponseByte('?'); + + return; + } + + /* Check if command is to read a memory block */ + if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_BlockRead) + { + /* Re-enable RWW section */ + boot_rww_enable(); + + while (BlockSize--) + { + if (MemoryType == MEMORY_TYPE_FLASH) + { + /* Read the next FLASH byte from the current FLASH page */ + #if (FLASHEND > 0xFFFF) + WriteNextResponseByte(pgm_read_byte_far(CurrAddress | HighByte)); + #else + WriteNextResponseByte(pgm_read_byte(CurrAddress | HighByte)); + #endif + + /* If both bytes in current word have been read, increment the address counter */ + if (HighByte) + CurrAddress += 2; + + HighByte = !HighByte; + } + else + { + /* Read the next EEPROM byte into the endpoint */ + WriteNextResponseByte(eeprom_read_byte((uint8_t*)(intptr_t)(CurrAddress >> 1))); + + /* Increment the address counter after use */ + CurrAddress += 2; + } + } + } + else + { + uint32_t PageStartAddress = CurrAddress; + + if (MemoryType == MEMORY_TYPE_FLASH) + { + boot_page_erase(PageStartAddress); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + } + + while (BlockSize--) + { + if (MemoryType == MEMORY_TYPE_FLASH) + { + /* If both bytes in current word have been written, increment the address counter */ + if (HighByte) + { + /* Write the next FLASH word to the current FLASH page */ + boot_page_fill(CurrAddress, ((FetchNextCommandByte() << 8) | LowByte)); + + /* Increment the address counter after use */ + CurrAddress += 2; + } + else + { + LowByte = FetchNextCommandByte(); + } + + HighByte = !HighByte; + } + else + { + /* Write the next EEPROM byte from the endpoint */ + eeprom_update_byte((uint8_t*)((intptr_t)(CurrAddress >> 1)), FetchNextCommandByte()); + + /* Increment the address counter after use */ + CurrAddress += 2; + } + } + + /* If in FLASH programming mode, commit the page after writing */ + if (MemoryType == MEMORY_TYPE_FLASH) + { + /* Commit the flash page to memory */ + boot_page_write(PageStartAddress); + + /* Wait until write operation has completed */ + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + } + + /* Send response byte back to the host */ + WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); + } +} +#endif + +/** Retrieves the next byte from the host in the CDC data OUT endpoint, and clears the endpoint bank if needed + * to allow reception of the next data packet from the host. + * + * \return Next received byte from the host in the CDC data OUT endpoint + */ +static uint8_t FetchNextCommandByte(void) +{ + /* Select the OUT endpoint so that the next data byte can be read */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPADDR); + + /* If OUT endpoint empty, clear it and wait for the next packet from the host */ + while (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return 0; + } + } + + /* Fetch the next byte from the OUT endpoint */ + return Endpoint_Read_8(); +} + +/** Writes the next response byte to the CDC data IN endpoint, and sends the endpoint back if needed to free up the + * bank when full ready for the next byte in the packet to the host. + * + * \param[in] Response Next response byte to send to the host + */ +static void WriteNextResponseByte(const uint8_t Response) +{ + /* Select the IN endpoint so that the next data byte can be written */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPADDR); + + /* If IN endpoint full, clear it and wait until ready for the next packet to the host */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + } + + /* Write the next byte to the IN endpoint */ + Endpoint_Write_8(Response); +} + +/** Task to read in AVR109 commands from the CDC data OUT endpoint, process them, perform the required actions + * and send the appropriate response back to the host. + */ +static void CDC_Task(void) +{ + /* Select the OUT endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPADDR); + + /* Check if endpoint has a command in it sent from the host */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) + return; + + /* Read in the bootloader command (first byte sent from host) */ + uint8_t Command = FetchNextCommandByte(); + + if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ExitBootloader) + { + RunBootloader = false; + + /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ + WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); + } + else if ((Command == AVR109_COMMAND_SetLED) || (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ClearLED) || + (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_SelectDeviceType)) + { + FetchNextCommandByte(); + + /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ + WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); + } + else if ((Command == AVR109_COMMAND_EnterProgrammingMode) || (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_LeaveProgrammingMode)) + { + /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ + WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); + } + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadPartCode) + { + /* Return ATMEGA128 part code - this is only to allow AVRProg to use the bootloader */ + WriteNextResponseByte(0x44); + WriteNextResponseByte(0x00); + } + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadAutoAddressIncrement) + { + /* Indicate auto-address increment is supported */ + WriteNextResponseByte('Y'); + } + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_SetCurrentAddress) + { + /* Set the current address to that given by the host (translate 16-bit word address to byte address) */ + CurrAddress = (FetchNextCommandByte() << 9); + CurrAddress |= (FetchNextCommandByte() << 1); + + /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ + WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); + } + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadBootloaderInterface) + { + /* Indicate serial programmer back to the host */ + WriteNextResponseByte('S'); + } + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadBootloaderIdentifier) + { + /* Write the 7-byte software identifier to the endpoint */ + for (uint8_t CurrByte = 0; CurrByte < 7; CurrByte++) + WriteNextResponseByte(SOFTWARE_IDENTIFIER[CurrByte]); + } + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadBootloaderSWVersion) + { + WriteNextResponseByte('0' + BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MAJOR); + WriteNextResponseByte('0' + BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR); + } + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadSignature) + { + WriteNextResponseByte(AVR_SIGNATURE_3); + WriteNextResponseByte(AVR_SIGNATURE_2); + WriteNextResponseByte(AVR_SIGNATURE_1); + } + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_EraseFLASH) + { + /* Clear the application section of flash */ + for (uint32_t CurrFlashAddress = 0; CurrFlashAddress < (uint32_t)BOOT_START_ADDR; CurrFlashAddress += SPM_PAGESIZE) + { + boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + boot_page_write(CurrFlashAddress); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + } + + /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ + WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); + } + #if !defined(NO_LOCK_BYTE_WRITE_SUPPORT) + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_WriteLockbits) + { + /* Set the lock bits to those given by the host */ + boot_lock_bits_set(FetchNextCommandByte()); + + /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ + WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); + } + #endif + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadLockbits) + { + WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_LOCK_BITS)); + } + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadLowFuses) + { + WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_LOW_FUSE_BITS)); + } + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadHighFuses) + { + WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_HIGH_FUSE_BITS)); + } + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadExtendedFuses) + { + WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_EXTENDED_FUSE_BITS)); + } + #if !defined(NO_BLOCK_SUPPORT) + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_GetBlockWriteSupport) + { + WriteNextResponseByte('Y'); + + /* Send block size to the host */ + WriteNextResponseByte(SPM_PAGESIZE >> 8); + WriteNextResponseByte(SPM_PAGESIZE & 0xFF); + } + else if ((Command == AVR109_COMMAND_BlockWrite) || (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_BlockRead)) + { + /* Delegate the block write/read to a separate function for clarity */ + ReadWriteMemoryBlock(Command); + } + #endif + #if !defined(NO_FLASH_BYTE_SUPPORT) + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_FillFlashPageWordHigh) + { + /* Write the high byte to the current flash page */ + boot_page_fill(CurrAddress, FetchNextCommandByte()); + + /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ + WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); + } + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_FillFlashPageWordLow) + { + /* Write the low byte to the current flash page */ + boot_page_fill(CurrAddress | 0x01, FetchNextCommandByte()); + + /* Increment the address */ + CurrAddress += 2; + + /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ + WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); + } + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_WriteFlashPage) + { + /* Commit the flash page to memory */ + boot_page_write(CurrAddress); + + /* Wait until write operation has completed */ + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + + /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ + WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); + } + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadFLASHWord) + { + #if (FLASHEND > 0xFFFF) + uint16_t ProgramWord = pgm_read_word_far(CurrAddress); + #else + uint16_t ProgramWord = pgm_read_word(CurrAddress); + #endif + + WriteNextResponseByte(ProgramWord >> 8); + WriteNextResponseByte(ProgramWord & 0xFF); + } + #endif + #if !defined(NO_EEPROM_BYTE_SUPPORT) + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_WriteEEPROM) + { + /* Read the byte from the endpoint and write it to the EEPROM */ + eeprom_update_byte((uint8_t*)((intptr_t)(CurrAddress >> 1)), FetchNextCommandByte()); + + /* Increment the address after use */ + CurrAddress += 2; + + /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */ + WriteNextResponseByte('\r'); + } + else if (Command == AVR109_COMMAND_ReadEEPROM) + { + /* Read the EEPROM byte and write it to the endpoint */ + WriteNextResponseByte(eeprom_read_byte((uint8_t*)((intptr_t)(CurrAddress >> 1)))); + + /* Increment the address after use */ + CurrAddress += 2; + } + #endif + else if (Command != AVR109_COMMAND_Sync) + { + /* Unknown (non-sync) command, return fail code */ + WriteNextResponseByte('?'); + } + + /* Select the IN endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPADDR); + + /* Remember if the endpoint is completely full before clearing it */ + bool IsEndpointFull = !(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed()); + + /* Send the endpoint data to the host */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* If a full endpoint's worth of data was sent, we need to send an empty packet afterwards to signal end of transfer */ + if (IsEndpointFull) + { + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } + + /* Wait until the data has been sent to the host */ + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + + /* Select the OUT endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPADDR); + + /* Acknowledge the command from the host */ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b6543aa738 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.h @@ -0,0 +1,144 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for BootloaderCDC.c. + */ + +#ifndef _CDC_H_ +#define _CDC_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/boot.h> + #include <avr/eeprom.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + #include "BootloaderAPI.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__OPTIMIZE_SIZE__) + #error This bootloader requires that it be optimized for size, not speed, to fit into the target device. Change optimization settings and try again. + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** Version major of the CDC bootloader. */ + #define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MAJOR 0x01 + + /** Version minor of the CDC bootloader. */ + #define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR 0x00 + + /** Hardware version major of the CDC bootloader. */ + #define BOOTLOADER_HWVERSION_MAJOR 0x01 + + /** Hardware version minor of the CDC bootloader. */ + #define BOOTLOADER_HWVERSION_MINOR 0x00 + + /** Eight character bootloader firmware identifier reported to the host when requested. */ + #define SOFTWARE_IDENTIFIER "LUFACDC" + + /** Magic bootloader key to unlock forced application start mode. */ + #define MAGIC_BOOT_KEY 0xDC42 + + /* Enums: */ + /** Possible memory types that can be addressed via the bootloader. */ + enum AVR109_Memories + { + MEMORY_TYPE_FLASH = 'F', + MEMORY_TYPE_EEPROM = 'E', + }; + + /** Possible commands that can be issued to the bootloader. */ + enum AVR109_Commands + { + AVR109_COMMAND_Sync = 27, + AVR109_COMMAND_ReadEEPROM = 'd', + AVR109_COMMAND_WriteEEPROM = 'D', + AVR109_COMMAND_ReadFLASHWord = 'R', + AVR109_COMMAND_WriteFlashPage = 'm', + AVR109_COMMAND_FillFlashPageWordLow = 'c', + AVR109_COMMAND_FillFlashPageWordHigh = 'C', + AVR109_COMMAND_GetBlockWriteSupport = 'b', + AVR109_COMMAND_BlockWrite = 'B', + AVR109_COMMAND_BlockRead = 'g', + AVR109_COMMAND_ReadExtendedFuses = 'Q', + AVR109_COMMAND_ReadHighFuses = 'N', + AVR109_COMMAND_ReadLowFuses = 'F', + AVR109_COMMAND_ReadLockbits = 'r', + AVR109_COMMAND_WriteLockbits = 'l', + AVR109_COMMAND_EraseFLASH = 'e', + AVR109_COMMAND_ReadSignature = 's', + AVR109_COMMAND_ReadBootloaderSWVersion = 'V', + AVR109_COMMAND_ReadBootloaderHWVersion = 'v', + AVR109_COMMAND_ReadBootloaderIdentifier = 'S', + AVR109_COMMAND_ReadBootloaderInterface = 'p', + AVR109_COMMAND_SetCurrentAddress = 'A', + AVR109_COMMAND_ReadAutoAddressIncrement = 'a', + AVR109_COMMAND_ReadPartCode = 't', + AVR109_COMMAND_EnterProgrammingMode = 'P', + AVR109_COMMAND_LeaveProgrammingMode = 'L', + AVR109_COMMAND_SelectDeviceType = 'T', + AVR109_COMMAND_SetLED = 'x', + AVR109_COMMAND_ClearLED = 'y', + AVR109_COMMAND_ExitBootloader = 'E', + }; + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a non-returning pointer to the start of the loaded application in flash memory. */ + typedef void (*AppPtr_t)(void) ATTR_NO_RETURN; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + static void CDC_Task(void); + static void SetupHardware(void); + + void Application_Jump_Check(void) ATTR_INIT_SECTION(3); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADERCDC_C) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #if !defined(NO_BLOCK_SUPPORT) + static void ReadWriteMemoryBlock(const uint8_t Command); + #endif + static uint8_t FetchNextCommandByte(void); + static void WriteNextResponseByte(const uint8_t Response); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.txt b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f8c349cded --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.txt @@ -0,0 +1,242 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage CDC Class USB AVR Bootloader + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Abstract Control Model (ACM)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF CDC Class Standard</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * This bootloader enumerates to the host as a CDC Class device (virtual serial port), allowing for AVR109 + * protocol compatible programming software to load firmware onto the AVR. + * + * Out of the box this bootloader builds for the AT90USB1287 with an 8KB bootloader section size, and will fit + * into 4KB of bootloader space. If you wish to alter this size and/or change the AVR model, you will need to + * edit the MCU, FLASH_SIZE_KB and BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB values in the accompanying makefile. + * + * When the bootloader is running, the board's LED(s) will flash at regular intervals to distinguish the + * bootloader from the normal user application. + * + * \warning <b>THIS BOOTLOADER IS NOT SECURE.</b> Malicious entities can recover written data, even if the device + * lockbits are set. + * + * \section Sec_Running Running the Bootloader + * + * On the USB AVR8 devices, setting the \c HWBE device fuse will cause the bootloader to run if the \c HWB pin of + * the AVR is grounded when the device is reset. + * + * The are two behaviours of this bootloader, depending on the device's fuses: + * + * <b>If the device's BOOTRST fuse is set</b>, the bootloader will run any time the system is reset from + * the external reset pin, unless no valid user application has been loaded. To initiate the bootloader, the + * device's external reset pin should be grounded momentarily. + * + * <b>If the device's BOOTRST fuse is not set</b>, the bootloader will run only if initiated via a software + * jump, or if the \c HWB pin was low during the last device reset (if the \c HWBE fuse is set). + * + * For board specific exceptions to the above, see below. + * + * \subsection SSec_XPLAIN Atmel Xplain Board + * Ground the USB AVR JTAG's \c TCK pin to ground when powering on the board to start the bootloader. This assumes the + * \c HWBE fuse is cleared and the \c BOOTRST fuse is set as the HWBE pin is not user accessible on this board. + * + * \subsection SSec_Leonardo Arduino Leonardo Board + * Ground \c IO13 when powering the board to start the bootloader. This assumes the \c HWBE fuse is cleared and the + * \c BOOTRST fuse is set as the HWBE pin is not user accessible on this board. + * + * \section Sec_Installation Driver Installation + * + * After running this bootloader for the first time on a new computer, you will need to supply the .INF + * file located in this bootloader project's directory as the device's driver when running under Windows. + * This will enable Windows to use its inbuilt CDC drivers, negating the need for custom drivers for the + * device. Other Operating Systems should automatically use their own inbuilt CDC-ACM drivers. + * + * \section Sec_HostApp Host Controller Application + * + * This bootloader is compatible with the open source application AVRDUDE, Atmel's AVRPROG, or other + * applications implementing the AVR109 protocol, which is documented on the Atmel website as an application + * note. + * + * \subsection SSec_AVRDude AVRDUDE (Windows, Mac, Linux) + * + * AVRDude is a free, cross-platform and open source command line programmer for Atmel and third party AVR + * programmers. It is available on the the Windows platform as part of the "WinAVR" package, or on other systems + * either from a build from the official source code, or in many distributions as a precompiled binary package. + * + * To load a new HEX file with AVRDude, specify "AVR109" as the programmer, with the allocated COM port. On Windows + * platforms this will be a COMx port name: + * \code + * avrdude -c AVR109 -p at90usb1287 -P COM0 -U flash:w:Mouse.hex + * \endcode + * + * On Linux systems, this will typically be a /dev/ttyACMx port name: + * \code + * avrdude -c AVR109 -p at90usb1287 -P /dev/ttyACM0 -U flash:w:Mouse.hex + * \endcode + * + * Refer to the AVRDude project documentation for additional usage instructions. + * + * \section Sec_API User Application API + * + * Several user application functions for FLASH and other special memory area manipulations are exposed by the bootloader, + * allowing the user application to call into the bootloader at runtime to read and write FLASH data. + * + * By default, the bootloader API jump table is located 32 bytes from the end of the device's FLASH memory, and follows the + * following layout: + * + * \code + * #define BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE 32 + * #define BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START ((FLASHEND + 1UL) - BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE) + * #define BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(Index) (void*)((BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (Index * 2)) / 2) + * + * void (*BootloaderAPI_ErasePage)(uint32_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(0); + * void (*BootloaderAPI_WritePage)(uint32_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(1); + * void (*BootloaderAPI_FillWord)(uint32_t Address, uint16_t Word) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(2); + * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature)(uint16_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(3); + * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse)(uint16_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(4); + * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadLock)(void) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(5); + * void (*BootloaderAPI_WriteLock)(uint8_t LockBits) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(6); + * + * #define BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 2)) + * #define BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE 0xDCFB + * + * #define BOOTLOADER_CLASS_SIGNATURE_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 4)) + * #define BOOTLOADER_CDC_SIGNATURE 0xDF00 + * + * #define BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 8)) + * #define BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_LENGTH 4 + * \endcode + * + * From the application the API support of the bootloader can be detected by reading the FLASH memory bytes located at address + * \c BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE_START and comparing them to the value \c BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE. The class of bootloader + * can be determined by reading the FLASH memory bytes located at address \c BOOTLOADER_CLASS_SIGNATURE_START and comparing them + * to the value \c BOOTLOADER_CDC_SIGNATURE. The start address of the bootloader can be retrieved by reading the bytes of FLASH + * memory starting from address \c BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_START. + * + * \subsection SSec_API_MemLayout Device Memory Map + * The following illustration indicates the final memory map of the device when loaded with the bootloader. + * + * \verbatim + * +----------------------------+ 0x0000 + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | User Application | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - BOOT_SECTION_SIZE + * | | + * | Bootloader Application | + * | (Not User App. Accessible) | + * | | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 96 + * | API Table Trampolines | + * | (Not User App. Accessible) | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 32 + * | Bootloader API Table | + * | (User App. Accessible) | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 8 + * | Bootloader ID Constants | + * | (User App. Accessible) | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND + * \endverbatim + * + * \section Sec_KnownIssues Known Issues: + * + * \par On Linux machines, the CDC bootloader is unstable or inaccessible. + * A change to the \c ModemManager module in many Linux distributions causes + * this module to try to take control over inserted CDC devices, corrupting the + * datastream. A UDEV rule is required to prevent this. + * See <a href=https://groups.google.com/d/msg/lufa-support/CP9cy2bc8yo/kBqsOu-RBeMJ>here</a> for resolution steps. + * If the issue still persists then uninstall modemmanager by executing <tt>sudo apt-get remove modemmanager</tt>, or + * the equivalent using your chosen distribution's package manager. + * + * \par On Linux machines, the CDC bootloader is inaccessible. + * On many Linux systems, non-root users do not have automatic access to newly + * inserted CDC devices. Root privileges or a UDEV rule is required to gain + * access. + * See <a href=https://groups.google.com/d/msg/lufa-support/CP9cy2bc8yo/kBqsOu-RBeMJ>here</a> for resolution steps. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_BLOCK_SUPPORT</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Define to disable memory block read/write support in the bootloader, requiring all reads and writes to be made + * using the byte-level commands.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_EEPROM_BYTE_SUPPORT</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Define to disable EEPROM memory byte read/write support in the bootloader, requiring all EEPROM reads and writes + * to be made using the block-level commands.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_FLASH_BYTE_SUPPORT</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Define to disable FLASH memory byte read/write support in the bootloader, requiring all FLASH reads and writes + * to be made using the block-level commands.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_LOCK_BYTE_WRITE_SUPPORT</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Define to disable lock byte write support in the bootloader, preventing the lock bits from being set programmatically.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..22972b72fe --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure LUFA's + * compile time options, as an alternative to the compile time + * constants supplied through a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + +// #define NO_BLOCK_SUPPORT +// #define NO_EEPROM_BYTE_SUPPORT +// #define NO_FLASH_BYTE_SUPPORT +// #define NO_LOCK_BYTE_WRITE_SUPPORT + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5aa0e765bf --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT + #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS + #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 + #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT + #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP + #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6276570373 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,244 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x204A, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(1,0,0), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED, + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .CDC_CCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Header = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = 0x00, + + .CDCSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + }, + + .CDC_Functional_ACM = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = 0x02, + + .Capabilities = 0x02, + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Union = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = 0x06, + + .MasterInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .SlaveInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + }, + + .CDC_NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0xFF + }, + + .CDC_DCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .CDC_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA CDC"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see LUFA library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + if (DescriptorNumber == STRING_ID_Language) + { + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = LanguageString.Header.Size; + } + else if (DescriptorNumber == STRING_ID_Manufacturer) + { + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = ManufacturerString.Header.Size; + } + else if (DescriptorNumber == STRING_ID_Product) + { + Address = &ProductString; + Size = ProductString.Header.Size; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a6fbf5262b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,158 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + #if defined(__AVR_AT90USB1287__) + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x97 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 + #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB647__) + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x96 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 + #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB1286__) + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x97 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 + #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB646__) + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x96 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 + #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega32U4__) + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x95 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x87 + #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega16U4__) + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x94 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x88 + #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega32U2__) + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x95 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x8A + #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega16U2__) + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x94 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x89 + #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB162__) + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x94 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 + #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega8U2__) + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x93 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x89 + #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB82__) + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x93 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 + #else + #error The selected AVR part is not currently supported by this bootloader. + #endif + + /** Endpoint address for the CDC control interface event notification endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 2) + + /** Endpoint address for the CDC data interface TX (data IN) endpoint. */ + #define CDC_TX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address for the CDC data interface RX (data OUT) endpoint. */ + #define CDC_RX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) + + /** Size of the CDC data interface TX and RX data endpoint banks, in bytes. */ + #define CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE 16 + + /** Size of the CDC control interface notification endpoint bank, in bytes. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE 8 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // CDC Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_CCI_Interface; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t CDC_Functional_Header; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t CDC_Functional_ACM; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t CDC_Functional_Union; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_NotificationEndpoint; + + // CDC Data Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_DCI_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataOutEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataInEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI = 0, /**< CDC CCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI = 1, /**< CDC DCI interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/LUFA CDC Bootloader.inf b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/LUFA CDC Bootloader.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..61624c7318 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/LUFA CDC Bootloader.inf @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +;************************************************************ +; Windows USB CDC ACM Setup File +; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation +;************************************************************ + +[DefaultInstall] +CopyINF="LUFA CDC Bootloader.inf" + +[Version] +Signature="$Windows NT$" +Class=Ports +ClassGuid={4D36E978-E325-11CE-BFC1-08002BE10318} +Provider=%MFGNAME% +DriverVer=7/1/2012,10.0.0.0 + +[Manufacturer] +%MFGNAME%=DeviceList, NTx86, NTamd64, NTia64 + +[SourceDisksNames] + +[SourceDisksFiles] + +[DestinationDirs] +DefaultDestDir=12 + +[DriverInstall] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +CopyFiles=FakeModemCopyFileSection +AddReg=DriverInstall.AddReg + +[DriverInstall.Services] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +AddService=usbser, 0x00000002, LowerFilter_Service_Inst + +[DriverInstall.AddReg] +HKR,,EnumPropPages32,,"msports.dll,SerialPortPropPageProvider" + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; Vendor and Product ID Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; When developing your USB device, the VID and PID used in the PC side +; application program and the firmware on the microcontroller must match. +; Modify the below line to use your VID and PID. Use the format as shown below. +; Note: One INF file can be used for multiple devices with different VID and PIDs. +; For each supported device, append ",USB\VID_xxxx&PID_yyyy" to the end of the line. +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[DeviceList] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204A + +[DeviceList.NTx86] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204A + +[DeviceList.NTamd64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204A + +[DeviceList.NTia64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204A + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; String Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +;Modify these strings to customize your device +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[Strings] +MFGNAME="http://www.lufa-lib.org" +DESCRIPTION="LUFA CDC Class Bootloader" diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..72f3ff04c7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,161 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="CDC Bootloader - 128KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.cdc.avr8.128_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_cdc_128kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.cdc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x1F000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x1F000"/>
+
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x1FFA0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x1FFE0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x1FFF8"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="CDC Bootloader - 64KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.cdc.avr8.64_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_cdc_64kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.cdc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb647"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0xF000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0xF000"/>
+
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0xFFA0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0xFFE0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0xFFF8"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="CDC Bootloader - 32KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.cdc.avr8.32_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_cdc_32kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.cdc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u4"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x7000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x7000"/>
+
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x7FA0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x7FE0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x7FF8"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="CDC Bootloader - 16KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.cdc.avr8.16_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_cdc_16kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.cdc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega16u2"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x3000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x3000"/>
+
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x3FA0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x3FE0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x3FF8"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="CDC Bootloader - 8KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.cdc.avr8.8_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_cdc_8kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.cdc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega8u2"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x1000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x1000"/>
+
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x1FA0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x1FE0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x1FF8"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.bootloaders.cdc" caption="CDC Bootloader">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ CDC Class Bootloader, capable of reprogramming a device using avrdude or other AVR109 protocol compliant software when plugged into a host.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Bootloaders"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value="."/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="BootloaderCDC.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="BootloaderCDC.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="BootloaderAPI.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="BootloaderAPI.h"/>
+ <build type="asm-source" value="BootloaderAPITable.S"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="BootloaderCDC.txt"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="LUFA CDC Bootloader.inf"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..414693479f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2396 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - CDC Class Bootloader" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM \ + ATTR_NO_INIT + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/makefile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..aa5a2117df --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = BootloaderCDC +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c BootloaderAPI.c BootloaderAPITable.S $(LUFA_SRC_USB) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ -DBOOT_START_ADDR=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET) +LD_FLAGS = -Wl,--section-start=.text=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET) $(BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS) + +# Flash size and bootloader section sizes of the target, in KB. These must +# match the target's total FLASH size and the bootloader size set in the +# device's fuses. +FLASH_SIZE_KB = 128 +BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB = 8 + +# Bootloader address calculation formulas +# Do not modify these macros, but rather modify the dependent values above. +CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX = $(shell printf "0x%X" $$(( $(1) )) ) +BOOT_START_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) - $(BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB)) * 1024 ) +BOOT_SEC_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) * 1024) - ($(strip $(1))) ) + +# Bootloader linker section flags for relocating the API table sections to +# known FLASH addresses - these should not normally be user-edited. +BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG = -Wl,--section-start=$(strip $(1))=$(call BOOT_SEC_OFFSET, $(3)) -Wl,--undefined=$(strip $(2)) +BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS = $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_trampolines, BootloaderAPI_Trampolines, 96) +BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS += $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_jumptable, BootloaderAPI_JumpTable, 32) +BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS += $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_signatures, BootloaderAPI_Signatures, 8) + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderAPI.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderAPI.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..491c506d0f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderAPI.c @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Bootloader user application API functions. + */ + +#include "BootloaderAPI.h" + +void BootloaderAPI_ErasePage(const uint32_t Address) +{ + boot_page_erase_safe(Address); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + boot_rww_enable(); +} + +void BootloaderAPI_WritePage(const uint32_t Address) +{ + boot_page_write_safe(Address); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + boot_rww_enable(); +} + +void BootloaderAPI_FillWord(const uint32_t Address, const uint16_t Word) +{ + boot_page_fill_safe(Address, Word); +} + +uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature(const uint16_t Address) +{ + return boot_signature_byte_get(Address); +} + +uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse(const uint16_t Address) +{ + return boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(Address); +} + +uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadLock(void) +{ + return boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_LOCK_BITS); +} + +void BootloaderAPI_WriteLock(const uint8_t LockBits) +{ + boot_lock_bits_set_safe(LockBits); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderAPI.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderAPI.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5169bbc3c4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderAPI.h @@ -0,0 +1,58 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for BootloaderAPI.c. + */ + +#ifndef _BOOTLOADER_API_H_ +#define _BOOTLOADER_API_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/boot.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void BootloaderAPI_ErasePage(const uint32_t Address); + void BootloaderAPI_WritePage(const uint32_t Address); + void BootloaderAPI_FillWord(const uint32_t Address, const uint16_t Word); + uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature(const uint16_t Address); + uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse(const uint16_t Address); + uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadLock(void); + void BootloaderAPI_WriteLock(const uint8_t LockBits); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderAPITable.S b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderAPITable.S new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..95fd8e5c37 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderAPITable.S @@ -0,0 +1,91 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +; Trampolines to actual API implementations if the target address is outside the +; range of a rjmp instruction (can happen with large bootloader sections) +.section .apitable_trampolines, "ax" +.global BootloaderAPI_Trampolines +BootloaderAPI_Trampolines: + + BootloaderAPI_ErasePage_Trampoline: + jmp BootloaderAPI_ErasePage + BootloaderAPI_WritePage_Trampoline: + jmp BootloaderAPI_WritePage + BootloaderAPI_FillWord_Trampoline: + jmp BootloaderAPI_FillWord + BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature_Trampoline: + jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature + BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse_Trampoline: + jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse + BootloaderAPI_ReadLock_Trampoline: + jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadLock + BootloaderAPI_WriteLock_Trampoline: + jmp BootloaderAPI_WriteLock + BootloaderAPI_UNUSED1: + ret + BootloaderAPI_UNUSED2: + ret + BootloaderAPI_UNUSED3: + ret + BootloaderAPI_UNUSED4: + ret + BootloaderAPI_UNUSED5: + ret + + + +; API function jump table +.section .apitable_jumptable, "ax" +.global BootloaderAPI_JumpTable +BootloaderAPI_JumpTable: + + rjmp BootloaderAPI_ErasePage_Trampoline + rjmp BootloaderAPI_WritePage_Trampoline + rjmp BootloaderAPI_FillWord_Trampoline + rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature_Trampoline + rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse_Trampoline + rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadLock_Trampoline + rjmp BootloaderAPI_WriteLock_Trampoline + rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED1 ; UNUSED ENTRY 1 + rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED2 ; UNUSED ENTRY 2 + rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED3 ; UNUSED ENTRY 3 + rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED4 ; UNUSED ENTRY 4 + rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED5 ; UNUSED ENTRY 5 + + + +; Bootloader table signatures and information +.section .apitable_signatures, "ax" +.global BootloaderAPI_Signatures +BootloaderAPI_Signatures: + + .long BOOT_START_ADDR ; Start address of the bootloader + .word 0xDF10 ; Signature for the DFU class bootloader, V1 + .word 0xDCFB ; Signature for a LUFA class bootloader diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..928cf6fe3b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.c @@ -0,0 +1,891 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the DFU class bootloader. This file contains the complete bootloader logic. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADER_C +#include "BootloaderDFU.h" + +/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader is currently running in secure mode, disallowing memory operations + * other than erase. This is initially set to the value set by SECURE_MODE, and cleared by the bootloader + * once a memory erase has completed in a bootloader session. + */ +static bool IsSecure = SECURE_MODE; + +/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader should be running, or should exit and allow the application code to run + * via a soft reset. When cleared, the bootloader will abort, the USB interface will shut down and the application + * jumped to via an indirect jump to location 0x0000 (or other location specified by the host). + */ +static bool RunBootloader = true; + +/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader is waiting to exit. When the host requests the bootloader to exit and + * jump to the application address it specifies, it sends two sequential commands which must be properly + * acknowledged. Upon reception of the first the RunBootloader flag is cleared and the WaitForExit flag is set, + * causing the bootloader to wait for the final exit command before shutting down. + */ +static bool WaitForExit = false; + +/** Current DFU state machine state, one of the values in the DFU_State_t enum. */ +static uint8_t DFU_State = dfuIDLE; + +/** Status code of the last executed DFU command. This is set to one of the values in the DFU_Status_t enum after + * each operation, and returned to the host when a Get Status DFU request is issued. + */ +static uint8_t DFU_Status = OK; + +/** Data containing the DFU command sent from the host. */ +static DFU_Command_t SentCommand; + +/** Response to the last issued Read Data DFU command. Unlike other DFU commands, the read command + * requires a single byte response from the bootloader containing the read data when the next DFU_UPLOAD command + * is issued by the host. + */ +static uint8_t ResponseByte; + +/** Pointer to the start of the user application. By default this is 0x0000 (the reset vector), however the host + * may specify an alternate address when issuing the application soft-start command. + */ +static AppPtr_t AppStartPtr = (AppPtr_t)0x0000; + +/** 64-bit flash page number. This is concatenated with the current 16-bit address on USB AVRs containing more than + * 64KB of flash memory. + */ +static uint8_t Flash64KBPage = 0; + +/** Memory start address, indicating the current address in the memory being addressed (either FLASH or EEPROM + * depending on the issued command from the host). + */ +static uint16_t StartAddr = 0x0000; + +/** Memory end address, indicating the end address to read from/write to in the memory being addressed (either FLASH + * of EEPROM depending on the issued command from the host). + */ +static uint16_t EndAddr = 0x0000; + +/** Magic lock for forced application start. If the HWBE fuse is programmed and BOOTRST is unprogrammed, the bootloader + * will start if the /HWB line of the AVR is held low and the system is reset. However, if the /HWB line is still held + * low when the application attempts to start via a watchdog reset, the bootloader will re-start. If set to the value + * \ref MAGIC_BOOT_KEY the special init function \ref Application_Jump_Check() will force the application to start. + */ +uint16_t MagicBootKey ATTR_NO_INIT; + + +/** Special startup routine to check if the bootloader was started via a watchdog reset, and if the magic application + * start key has been loaded into \ref MagicBootKey. If the bootloader started via the watchdog and the key is valid, + * this will force the user application to start via a software jump. + */ +void Application_Jump_Check(void) +{ + bool JumpToApplication = false; + + #if (BOARD == BOARD_LEONARDO) + /* Enable pull-up on the IO13 pin so we can use it to select the mode */ + PORTC |= (1 << 7); + Delay_MS(10); + + /* If IO13 is not jumpered to ground, start the user application instead */ + JumpToApplication = ((PINC & (1 << 7)) != 0); + + /* Disable pull-up after the check has completed */ + PORTC &= ~(1 << 7); + #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + /* Disable JTAG debugging */ + JTAG_DISABLE(); + + /* Enable pull-up on the JTAG TCK pin so we can use it to select the mode */ + PORTF |= (1 << 4); + Delay_MS(10); + + /* If the TCK pin is not jumpered to ground, start the user application instead */ + JumpToApplication = ((PINF & (1 << 4)) != 0); + + /* Re-enable JTAG debugging */ + JTAG_ENABLE(); + #else + /* Check if the device's BOOTRST fuse is set */ + if (boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_HIGH_FUSE_BITS) & FUSE_BOOTRST) + { + /* If the reset source was not an external reset or the key is correct, clear it and jump to the application */ + //if (!(MCUSR & (1 << EXTRF)) || (MagicBootKey == MAGIC_BOOT_KEY)) + // JumpToApplication = true; + + /* Clear reset source */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << EXTRF); + } + else + { + /* If the reset source was the bootloader and the key is correct, clear it and jump to the application; + * this can happen in the HWBE fuse is set, and the HBE pin is low during the watchdog reset */ + //if ((MCUSR & (1 << WDRF)) && (MagicBootKey == MAGIC_BOOT_KEY)) + // JumpToApplication = true; + + /* Clear reset source */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + } + #endif + + /* Don't run the user application if the reset vector is blank (no app loaded) */ + bool ApplicationValid = (pgm_read_word_near(0) != 0xFFFF); + + /* If a request has been made to jump to the user application, honor it */ + if (JumpToApplication && ApplicationValid) + { + /* Turn off the watchdog */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Clear the boot key and jump to the user application */ + MagicBootKey = 0; + + // cppcheck-suppress constStatement + ((void (*)(void))0x0000)(); + } +} + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the bootloader, then continuously + * runs the bootloader processing routine until instructed to soft-exit, or hard-reset via the watchdog to start + * the loaded application code. + */ +int main(void) +{ + /* Configure hardware required by the bootloader */ + SetupHardware(); + + /* Turn on first LED on the board to indicate that the bootloader has started */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2); + + /* Enable global interrupts so that the USB stack can function */ + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + + #if (BOARD == BOARD_QMK) + uint16_t keypress = 0; + #endif + + /* Run the USB management task while the bootloader is supposed to be running */ + while (RunBootloader || WaitForExit) { + USB_USBTask(); + #if (BOARD == BOARD_QMK) + bool pressed = (PIN(QMK_ESC_ROW) & NUM(QMK_ESC_ROW)); + if ((DFU_State == dfuIDLE) && (keypress > 5000) && pressed) { + break; + } + if (pressed) { + keypress++; + } else { + keypress = 0; + } + + #endif + } + + /* Reset configured hardware back to their original states for the user application */ + ResetHardware(); + + /* Start the user application */ + AppStartPtr(); +} + +/** Configures all hardware required for the bootloader. */ +static void SetupHardware(void) +{ + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); + + /* Relocate the interrupt vector table to the bootloader section */ + MCUCR = (1 << IVCE); + MCUCR = (1 << IVSEL); + + #if (BOARD == BOARD_QMK) + // column setup + DDR(QMK_ESC_COL) |= NUM(QMK_ESC_COL); + PORT(QMK_ESC_COL) |= NUM(QMK_ESC_COL); + + // row setup + DDR(QMK_ESC_ROW) |= NUM(QMK_ESC_ROW); + #endif + + /* Initialize the USB and other board hardware drivers */ + USB_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + + /* Bootloader active LED toggle timer initialization */ + TIMSK1 = (1 << TOIE1); + TCCR1B = ((1 << CS11) | (1 << CS10)); + +} + +/** Resets all configured hardware required for the bootloader back to their original states. */ +static void ResetHardware(void) +{ + /* Shut down the USB and other board hardware drivers */ + USB_Disable(); + LEDs_Disable(); + + /* Disable Bootloader active LED toggle timer */ + TIMSK1 = 0; + TCCR1B = 0; + + /* Relocate the interrupt vector table back to the application section */ + MCUCR = (1 << IVCE); + MCUCR = 0; + + #if (BOARD == BOARD_QMK) + DDR(QMK_ESC_COL) = PORT(QMK_ESC_COL) = DDR(QMK_ESC_ROW) = PORT(QMK_ESC_ROW) = 0; + #endif +} + +/** ISR to periodically toggle the LEDs on the board to indicate that the bootloader is active. */ +ISR(TIMER1_OVF_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to + * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing + * internally. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + /* Ignore any requests that aren't directed to the DFU interface */ + if ((USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType & (CONTROL_REQTYPE_TYPE | CONTROL_REQTYPE_RECIPIENT)) != + (REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + return; + } + + /* Activity - toggle indicator LEDs */ + LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2); + + /* Get the size of the command and data from the wLength value */ + SentCommand.DataSize = USB_ControlRequest.wLength; + + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case DFU_REQ_DNLOAD: + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Check if bootloader is waiting to terminate */ + if (WaitForExit) + { + /* Bootloader is terminating - process last received command */ + ProcessBootloaderCommand(); + + /* Indicate that the last command has now been processed - free to exit bootloader */ + WaitForExit = false; + } + + /* If the request has a data stage, load it into the command struct */ + if (SentCommand.DataSize) + { + while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + + /* First byte of the data stage is the DNLOAD request's command */ + SentCommand.Command = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + /* One byte of the data stage is the command, so subtract it from the total data bytes */ + SentCommand.DataSize--; + + /* Load in the rest of the data stage as command parameters */ + for (uint8_t DataByte = 0; (DataByte < sizeof(SentCommand.Data)) && + Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint(); DataByte++) + { + SentCommand.Data[DataByte] = Endpoint_Read_8(); + SentCommand.DataSize--; + } + + /* Process the command */ + ProcessBootloaderCommand(); + } + + /* Check if currently downloading firmware */ + if (DFU_State == dfuDNLOAD_IDLE) + { + if (!(SentCommand.DataSize)) + { + DFU_State = dfuIDLE; + } + else + { + /* Throw away the filler bytes before the start of the firmware */ + DiscardFillerBytes(DFU_FILLER_BYTES_SIZE); + + /* Throw away the packet alignment filler bytes before the start of the firmware */ + DiscardFillerBytes(StartAddr % FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE); + + /* Calculate the number of bytes remaining to be written */ + uint16_t BytesRemaining = ((EndAddr - StartAddr) + 1); + + if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00)) // Write flash + { + /* Calculate the number of words to be written from the number of bytes to be written */ + uint16_t WordsRemaining = (BytesRemaining >> 1); + + union + { + uint16_t Words[2]; + uint32_t Long; + } CurrFlashAddress = {.Words = {StartAddr, Flash64KBPage}}; + + uint32_t CurrFlashPageStartAddress = CurrFlashAddress.Long; + uint8_t WordsInFlashPage = 0; + + while (WordsRemaining--) + { + /* Check if endpoint is empty - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */ + if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint())) + { + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + } + + /* Write the next word into the current flash page */ + boot_page_fill(CurrFlashAddress.Long, Endpoint_Read_16_LE()); + + /* Adjust counters */ + WordsInFlashPage += 1; + CurrFlashAddress.Long += 2; + + /* See if an entire page has been written to the flash page buffer */ + if ((WordsInFlashPage == (SPM_PAGESIZE >> 1)) || !(WordsRemaining)) + { + /* Commit the flash page to memory */ + boot_page_write(CurrFlashPageStartAddress); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + + /* Check if programming incomplete */ + if (WordsRemaining) + { + CurrFlashPageStartAddress = CurrFlashAddress.Long; + WordsInFlashPage = 0; + + /* Erase next page's temp buffer */ + boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress.Long); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + } + } + } + + /* Once programming complete, start address equals the end address */ + StartAddr = EndAddr; + + /* Re-enable the RWW section of flash */ + boot_rww_enable(); + } + else // Write EEPROM + { + while (BytesRemaining--) + { + /* Check if endpoint is empty - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */ + if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint())) + { + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + } + + /* Read the byte from the USB interface and write to to the EEPROM */ + eeprom_update_byte((uint8_t*)StartAddr, Endpoint_Read_8()); + + /* Adjust counters */ + StartAddr++; + } + } + + /* Throw away the currently unused DFU file suffix */ + DiscardFillerBytes(DFU_FILE_SUFFIX_SIZE); + } + } + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + break; + case DFU_REQ_UPLOAD: + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + + if (DFU_State != dfuUPLOAD_IDLE) + { + if ((DFU_State == dfuERROR) && IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01)) // Blank Check + { + /* Blank checking is performed in the DFU_DNLOAD request - if we get here we've told the host + that the memory isn't blank, and the host is requesting the first non-blank address */ + Endpoint_Write_16_LE(StartAddr); + } + else + { + /* Idle state upload - send response to last issued command */ + Endpoint_Write_8(ResponseByte); + } + } + else + { + /* Determine the number of bytes remaining in the current block */ + uint16_t BytesRemaining = ((EndAddr - StartAddr) + 1); + + if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00)) // Read FLASH + { + /* Calculate the number of words to be written from the number of bytes to be written */ + uint16_t WordsRemaining = (BytesRemaining >> 1); + + union + { + uint16_t Words[2]; + uint32_t Long; + } CurrFlashAddress = {.Words = {StartAddr, Flash64KBPage}}; + + while (WordsRemaining--) + { + /* Check if endpoint is full - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */ + if (Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint() == FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE) + { + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + } + + /* Read the flash word and send it via USB to the host */ + #if (FLASHEND > 0xFFFF) + Endpoint_Write_16_LE(pgm_read_word_far(CurrFlashAddress.Long)); + #else + Endpoint_Write_16_LE(pgm_read_word(CurrFlashAddress.Long)); + #endif + + /* Adjust counters */ + CurrFlashAddress.Long += 2; + } + + /* Once reading is complete, start address equals the end address */ + StartAddr = EndAddr; + } + else if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x02)) // Read EEPROM + { + while (BytesRemaining--) + { + /* Check if endpoint is full - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */ + if (Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint() == FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE) + { + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + } + + /* Read the EEPROM byte and send it via USB to the host */ + Endpoint_Write_8(eeprom_read_byte((uint8_t*)StartAddr)); + + /* Adjust counters */ + StartAddr++; + } + } + + /* Return to idle state */ + DFU_State = dfuIDLE; + } + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + break; + case DFU_REQ_GETSTATUS: + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + + /* Write 8-bit status value */ + Endpoint_Write_8(DFU_Status); + + /* Write 24-bit poll timeout value */ + Endpoint_Write_8(0); + Endpoint_Write_16_LE(0); + + /* Write 8-bit state value */ + Endpoint_Write_8(DFU_State); + + /* Write 8-bit state string ID number */ + Endpoint_Write_8(0); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + break; + case DFU_REQ_CLRSTATUS: + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Reset the status value variable to the default OK status */ + DFU_Status = OK; + + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + break; + case DFU_REQ_GETSTATE: + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + + /* Write the current device state to the endpoint */ + Endpoint_Write_8(DFU_State); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + break; + case DFU_REQ_ABORT: + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Reset the current state variable to the default idle state */ + DFU_State = dfuIDLE; + + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + break; + } +} + +/** Routine to discard the specified number of bytes from the control endpoint stream. This is used to + * discard unused bytes in the stream from the host, including the memory program block suffix. + * + * \param[in] NumberOfBytes Number of bytes to discard from the host from the control endpoint + */ +static void DiscardFillerBytes(uint8_t NumberOfBytes) +{ + while (NumberOfBytes--) + { + if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint())) + { + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + /* Wait until next data packet received */ + while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + } + else + { + Endpoint_Discard_8(); + } + } +} + +/** Routine to process an issued command from the host, via a DFU_DNLOAD request wrapper. This routine ensures + * that the command is allowed based on the current secure mode flag value, and passes the command off to the + * appropriate handler function. + */ +static void ProcessBootloaderCommand(void) +{ + /* Check if device is in secure mode */ + if (IsSecure) + { + /* Don't process command unless it is a READ or chip erase command */ + if (!(((SentCommand.Command == COMMAND_WRITE) && + IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00, 0xFF)) || + (SentCommand.Command == COMMAND_READ))) + { + /* Set the state and status variables to indicate the error */ + DFU_State = dfuERROR; + DFU_Status = errWRITE; + + /* Stall command */ + Endpoint_StallTransaction(); + + /* Don't process the command */ + return; + } + } + + /* Dispatch the required command processing routine based on the command type */ + switch (SentCommand.Command) + { + case COMMAND_PROG_START: + ProcessMemProgCommand(); + break; + case COMMAND_DISP_DATA: + ProcessMemReadCommand(); + break; + case COMMAND_WRITE: + ProcessWriteCommand(); + break; + case COMMAND_READ: + ProcessReadCommand(); + break; + case COMMAND_CHANGE_BASE_ADDR: + if (IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x03, 0x00)) // Set 64KB flash page command + Flash64KBPage = SentCommand.Data[2]; + + break; + } +} + +/** Routine to concatenate the given pair of 16-bit memory start and end addresses from the host, and store them + * in the StartAddr and EndAddr global variables. + */ +static void LoadStartEndAddresses(void) +{ + union + { + uint8_t Bytes[2]; + uint16_t Word; + } Address[2] = {{.Bytes = {SentCommand.Data[2], SentCommand.Data[1]}}, + {.Bytes = {SentCommand.Data[4], SentCommand.Data[3]}}}; + + /* Load in the start and ending read addresses from the sent data packet */ + StartAddr = Address[0].Word; + EndAddr = Address[1].Word; +} + +/** Handler for a Memory Program command issued by the host. This routine handles the preparations needed + * to write subsequent data from the host into the specified memory. + */ +static void ProcessMemProgCommand(void) +{ + if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00) || // Write FLASH command + IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01)) // Write EEPROM command + { + /* Load in the start and ending read addresses */ + LoadStartEndAddresses(); + + /* If FLASH is being written to, we need to pre-erase the first page to write to */ + if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00)) + { + union + { + uint16_t Words[2]; + uint32_t Long; + } CurrFlashAddress = {.Words = {StartAddr, Flash64KBPage}}; + + /* Erase the current page's temp buffer */ + boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress.Long); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + } + + /* Set the state so that the next DNLOAD requests reads in the firmware */ + DFU_State = dfuDNLOAD_IDLE; + } +} + +/** Handler for a Memory Read command issued by the host. This routine handles the preparations needed + * to read subsequent data from the specified memory out to the host, as well as implementing the memory + * blank check command. + */ +static void ProcessMemReadCommand(void) +{ + if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00) || // Read FLASH command + IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x02)) // Read EEPROM command + { + /* Load in the start and ending read addresses */ + LoadStartEndAddresses(); + + /* Set the state so that the next UPLOAD requests read out the firmware */ + DFU_State = dfuUPLOAD_IDLE; + } + else if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01)) // Blank check FLASH command + { + uint32_t CurrFlashAddress = 0; + + while (CurrFlashAddress < (uint32_t)BOOT_START_ADDR) + { + /* Check if the current byte is not blank */ + #if (FLASHEND > 0xFFFF) + if (pgm_read_byte_far(CurrFlashAddress) != 0xFF) + #else + if (pgm_read_byte(CurrFlashAddress) != 0xFF) + #endif + { + /* Save the location of the first non-blank byte for response back to the host */ + Flash64KBPage = (CurrFlashAddress >> 16); + StartAddr = CurrFlashAddress; + + /* Set state and status variables to the appropriate error values */ + DFU_State = dfuERROR; + DFU_Status = errCHECK_ERASED; + + break; + } + + CurrFlashAddress++; + } + } +} + +/** Handler for a Data Write command issued by the host. This routine handles non-programming commands such as + * bootloader exit (both via software jumps and hardware watchdog resets) and flash memory erasure. + */ +static void ProcessWriteCommand(void) +{ + if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x03)) // Start application + { + /* Indicate that the bootloader is terminating */ + WaitForExit = true; + + /* Check if data supplied for the Start Program command - no data executes the program */ + if (SentCommand.DataSize) + { + if (SentCommand.Data[1] == 0x01) // Start via jump + { + union + { + uint8_t Bytes[2]; + AppPtr_t FuncPtr; + } Address = {.Bytes = {SentCommand.Data[4], SentCommand.Data[3]}}; + + /* Load in the jump address into the application start address pointer */ + AppStartPtr = Address.FuncPtr; + } + } + else + { + if (SentCommand.Data[1] == 0x00) // Start via watchdog + { + /* Unlock the forced application start mode of the bootloader if it is restarted */ + MagicBootKey = MAGIC_BOOT_KEY; + + /* Start the watchdog to reset the AVR once the communications are finalized */ + wdt_enable(WDTO_250MS); + } + else // Start via jump + { + /* Set the flag to terminate the bootloader at next opportunity if a valid application has been loaded */ + if (pgm_read_word_near(0) == 0xFFFF) + RunBootloader = false; + } + } + } + else if (IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00, 0xFF)) // Erase flash + { + uint32_t CurrFlashAddress = 0; + + /* Clear the application section of flash */ + while (CurrFlashAddress < (uint32_t)BOOT_START_ADDR) + { + boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + boot_page_write(CurrFlashAddress); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + + CurrFlashAddress += SPM_PAGESIZE; + } + + /* Re-enable the RWW section of flash as writing to the flash locks it out */ + boot_rww_enable(); + + /* Memory has been erased, reset the security bit so that programming/reading is allowed */ + IsSecure = false; + } +} + +/** Handler for a Data Read command issued by the host. This routine handles bootloader information retrieval + * commands such as device signature and bootloader version retrieval. + */ +static void ProcessReadCommand(void) +{ + const uint8_t BootloaderInfo[3] = {BOOTLOADER_VERSION, BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE1, BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE2}; + const uint8_t SignatureInfo[4] = {0x58, AVR_SIGNATURE_1, AVR_SIGNATURE_2, AVR_SIGNATURE_3}; + + uint8_t DataIndexToRead = SentCommand.Data[1]; + bool ReadAddressInvalid = false; + + if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00)) // Read bootloader info + { + if (DataIndexToRead < 3) + ResponseByte = BootloaderInfo[DataIndexToRead]; + else + ReadAddressInvalid = true; + } + else if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01)) // Read signature byte + { + switch (DataIndexToRead) + { + case 0x30: + ResponseByte = SignatureInfo[0]; + break; + case 0x31: + ResponseByte = SignatureInfo[1]; + break; + case 0x60: + ResponseByte = SignatureInfo[2]; + break; + case 0x61: + ResponseByte = SignatureInfo[3]; + break; + default: + ReadAddressInvalid = true; + break; + } + } + + if (ReadAddressInvalid) + { + /* Set the state and status variables to indicate the error */ + DFU_State = dfuERROR; + DFU_Status = errADDRESS; + } +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a97ba6c7ef --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.h @@ -0,0 +1,216 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for BootloaderDFU.c. + */ + +#ifndef _BOOTLOADER_H_ +#define _BOOTLOADER_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/boot.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/eeprom.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <util/delay.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + #include "BootloaderAPI.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__OPTIMIZE_SIZE__) + #error This bootloader requires that it be optimized for size, not speed, to fit into the target device. Change optimization settings and try again. + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** Major bootloader version number. */ + #define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR 2 + + /** Minor bootloader version number. */ + #define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_REV 0 + + /** Magic bootloader key to unlock forced application start mode. */ + #define MAGIC_BOOT_KEY 0xDC42 + + /** Complete bootloader version number expressed as a packed byte, constructed from the + * two individual bootloader version macros. + */ + #define BOOTLOADER_VERSION ((BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR << 4) | BOOTLOADER_VERSION_REV) + + /** First byte of the bootloader identification bytes, used to identify a device's bootloader. */ + #define BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE1 0xDC + + /** Second byte of the bootloader identification bytes, used to identify a device's bootloader. */ + #define BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE2 0xFB + + /** Convenience macro, used to determine if the issued command is the given one-byte long command. + * + * \param[in] dataarr Command byte array to check against + * \param[in] cb1 First command byte to check + */ + #define IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(dataarr, cb1) (dataarr[0] == (cb1)) + + /** Convenience macro, used to determine if the issued command is the given two-byte long command. + * + * \param[in] dataarr Command byte array to check against + * \param[in] cb1 First command byte to check + * \param[in] cb2 Second command byte to check + */ + #define IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(dataarr, cb1, cb2) ((dataarr[0] == (cb1)) && (dataarr[1] == (cb2))) + + /** Length of the DFU file suffix block, appended to the end of each complete memory write command. + * The DFU file suffix is currently unused (but is designed to give extra file information, such as + * a CRC of the complete firmware for error checking) and so is discarded. + */ + #define DFU_FILE_SUFFIX_SIZE 16 + + /** Length of the DFU file filler block, appended to the start of each complete memory write command. + * Filler bytes are added to the start of each complete memory write command, and must be discarded. + */ + #define DFU_FILLER_BYTES_SIZE 26 + + /** DFU class command request to detach from the host. */ + #define DFU_REQ_DETATCH 0x00 + + /** DFU class command request to send data from the host to the bootloader. */ + #define DFU_REQ_DNLOAD 0x01 + + /** DFU class command request to send data from the bootloader to the host. */ + #define DFU_REQ_UPLOAD 0x02 + + /** DFU class command request to get the current DFU status and state from the bootloader. */ + #define DFU_REQ_GETSTATUS 0x03 + + /** DFU class command request to reset the current DFU status and state variables to their defaults. */ + #define DFU_REQ_CLRSTATUS 0x04 + + /** DFU class command request to get the current DFU state of the bootloader. */ + #define DFU_REQ_GETSTATE 0x05 + + /** DFU class command request to abort the current multi-request transfer and return to the dfuIDLE state. */ + #define DFU_REQ_ABORT 0x06 + + /** DFU command to begin programming the device's memory. */ + #define COMMAND_PROG_START 0x01 + + /** DFU command to begin reading the device's memory. */ + #define COMMAND_DISP_DATA 0x03 + + /** DFU command to issue a write command. */ + #define COMMAND_WRITE 0x04 + + /** DFU command to issue a read command. */ + #define COMMAND_READ 0x05 + + /** DFU command to issue a memory base address change command, to set the current 64KB flash page + * that subsequent flash operations should use. */ + #define COMMAND_CHANGE_BASE_ADDR 0x06 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a non-returning function pointer to the loaded application. */ + typedef void (*AppPtr_t)(void) ATTR_NO_RETURN; + + /** Type define for a structure containing a complete DFU command issued by the host. */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Command; /**< Single byte command to perform, one of the \c COMMAND_* macro values */ + uint8_t Data[5]; /**< Command parameters */ + uint16_t DataSize; /**< Size of the command parameters */ + } DFU_Command_t; + + /* Enums: */ + /** DFU bootloader states. Refer to the DFU class specification for information on each state. */ + enum DFU_State_t + { + appIDLE = 0, + appDETACH = 1, + dfuIDLE = 2, + dfuDNLOAD_SYNC = 3, + dfuDNBUSY = 4, + dfuDNLOAD_IDLE = 5, + dfuMANIFEST_SYNC = 6, + dfuMANIFEST = 7, + dfuMANIFEST_WAIT_RESET = 8, + dfuUPLOAD_IDLE = 9, + dfuERROR = 10 + }; + + /** DFU command status error codes. Refer to the DFU class specification for information on each error code. */ + enum DFU_Status_t + { + OK = 0, + errTARGET = 1, + errFILE = 2, + errWRITE = 3, + errERASE = 4, + errCHECK_ERASED = 5, + errPROG = 6, + errVERIFY = 7, + errADDRESS = 8, + errNOTDONE = 9, + errFIRMWARE = 10, + errVENDOR = 11, + errUSBR = 12, + errPOR = 13, + errUNKNOWN = 14, + errSTALLEDPKT = 15 + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + static void SetupHardware(void); + static void ResetHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADER_C) + static void DiscardFillerBytes(uint8_t NumberOfBytes); + static void ProcessBootloaderCommand(void); + static void LoadStartEndAddresses(void); + static void ProcessMemProgCommand(void); + static void ProcessMemReadCommand(void); + static void ProcessWriteCommand(void); + static void ProcessReadCommand(void); + #endif + + void Application_Jump_Check(void) ATTR_INIT_SECTION(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.txt b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b2540a5b6c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.txt @@ -0,0 +1,235 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage DFU Class USB AVR Bootloader + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) - <i>See \ref SSec_Aux_Space</i> + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) - <i>See \ref SSec_Aux_Space</i> + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Device Firmware Update Class (DFU)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>None</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF DFU Class Standard, Atmel USB Bootloader Datasheet</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * This bootloader enumerates to the host as a DFU Class device, allowing for DFU-compatible programming + * software to load firmware onto the AVR. + * + * Out of the box this bootloader builds for the AT90USB1287 with an 8KB bootloader section size, and will fit + * into 4KB of bootloader space. If you wish to alter this size and/or change the AVR model, you will need to + * edit the MCU, FLASH_SIZE_KB and BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB values in the accompanying makefile. + * + * When the bootloader is running, the board's LED(s) will flash at regular intervals to distinguish the + * bootloader from the normal user application. + * + * \section Sec_Running Running the Bootloader + * + * On the USB AVR8 devices, setting the \c HWBE device fuse will cause the bootloader to run if the \c HWB pin of + * the AVR is grounded when the device is reset. + * + * The are two behaviours of this bootloader, depending on the device's fuses: + * + * <b>If the device's BOOTRST fuse is set</b>, the bootloader will run any time the system is reset from + * the external reset pin, unless no valid user application has been loaded. To initiate the bootloader, the + * device's external reset pin should be grounded momentarily. + * + * <b>If the device's BOOTRST fuse is not set</b>, the bootloader will run only if initiated via a software + * jump, or if the \c HWB pin was low during the last device reset (if the \c HWBE fuse is set). + * + * For board specific exceptions to the above, see below. + * + * \subsection SSec_XPLAIN Atmel Xplain Board + * Ground the USB AVR JTAG's \c TCK pin to ground when powering on the board to start the bootloader. This assumes the + * \c HWBE fuse is cleared and the \c BOOTRST fuse is set as the HWBE pin is not user accessible on this board. + * + * \subsection SSec_Leonardo Arduino Leonardo Board + * Ground \c IO13 when powering the board to start the bootloader. This assumes the \c HWBE fuse is cleared and the + * \c BOOTRST fuse is set as the HWBE pin is not user accessible on this board. + * + * \section Sec_Installation Driver Installation + * + * This bootloader is designed to be compatible with Atmel's provided Windows DFU class drivers. You will need to + * install Atmel's DFU drivers prior to using this bootloader on Windows platforms. If you are using a 64 bit Windows + * OS, you will need to either disable the driver signing requirement (see online tutorials for details) or use a + * digitally signed version of the official Atmel driver provided by a third party AVR user at + * <a>http://www.avrfreaks.net/index.php?module=Freaks%20Academy&func=viewItem&item_id=2196&item_type=project</a>. + * + * \note This device spoofs Atmel's DFU Bootloader USB VID and PID so that the Atmel DFU bootloader + * drivers included with FLIP will work. If you do not wish to use Atmel's ID codes, please + * manually change them in Descriptors.c and alter your driver's INF file accordingly. + * + * \section Sec_HostApp Host Controller Application + * + * This bootloader is compatible with Atmel's FLIP utility on Windows machines, and dfu-programmer on Linux machines. + * + * \subsection SSec_FLIP FLIP (Windows) + * + * FLIP (Flexible In-System Programmer) is a utility written by Atmel, and distributed for free on the Atmel website. + * The FLIP utility is designed to assist in the bootloader programming of a range of Atmel devices, through several + * popular physical interfaces including USB. It is written in Java, however makes use of native extensions for USB + * support and thus is only offered on Windows. + * + * To program a device using FLIP, refer to the Atmel FLIP documentation. + * + * \subsection SSec_DFUProgrammer dfu-programmer (Linux) + * + * dfu-programmer is an open-source command line solution for the bootloader programming of Atmel devices through a + * USB connection, using the DFU protocol, available for download at <a>http://sourceforge.net/projects/dfu-programmer/</a>. + * + * The following example loads a HEX file into the AVR's FLASH memory using dfu-programmer: + * \code + * dfu-programmer at90usb1287 erase flash Mouse.hex + * \endcode + * + * \section Sec_API User Application API + * + * Several user application functions for FLASH and other special memory area manipulations are exposed by the bootloader, + * allowing the user application to call into the bootloader at runtime to read and write FLASH data. + * + * \warning The APIs exposed by the DFU class bootloader are \b NOT compatible with the API exposed by the official Atmel DFU bootloader. + * + * By default, the bootloader API jump table is located 32 bytes from the end of the device's FLASH memory, and follows the + * following layout: + * + * \code + * #define BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE 32 + * #define BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START ((FLASHEND + 1UL) - BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE) + * #define BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(Index) (void*)((BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (Index * 2)) / 2) + * + * void (*BootloaderAPI_ErasePage)(uint32_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(0); + * void (*BootloaderAPI_WritePage)(uint32_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(1); + * void (*BootloaderAPI_FillWord)(uint32_t Address, uint16_t Word) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(2); + * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature)(uint16_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(3); + * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse)(uint16_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(4); + * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadLock)(void) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(5); + * void (*BootloaderAPI_WriteLock)(uint8_t LockBits) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(6); + * + * #define BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 2)) + * #define BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE 0xDCFB + * + * #define BOOTLOADER_CLASS_SIGNATURE_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 4)) + * #define BOOTLOADER_DFU_SIGNATURE 0xDF10 + * + * #define BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 8)) + * #define BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_LENGTH 4 + * \endcode + * + * From the application the API support of the bootloader can be detected by reading the FLASH memory bytes located at address + * \c BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE_START and comparing them to the value \c BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE. The class of bootloader + * can be determined by reading the FLASH memory bytes located at address \c BOOTLOADER_CLASS_SIGNATURE_START and comparing them + * to the value \c BOOTLOADER_DFU_SIGNATURE. The start address of the bootloader can be retrieved by reading the bytes of FLASH + * memory starting from address \c BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_START. + * + * \subsection SSec_API_MemLayout Device Memory Map + * The following illustration indicates the final memory map of the device when loaded with the bootloader. + * + * \verbatim + * +----------------------------+ 0x0000 + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | User Application | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - BOOT_AUX_SECTION_SIZE + * | Booloader Start Trampoline | + * | (Not User App. Accessible) | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - (BOOT_AUX_SECTION_SIZE - 4) + * | | + * | Auxillery Bootloader | + * | Space for Smaller Devices | + * | (Not User App. Accessible) | + * | | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - BOOT_SECTION_SIZE + * | | + * | Bootloader Application | + * | (Not User App. Accessible) | + * | | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 96 + * | API Table Trampolines | + * | (Not User App. Accessible) | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 32 + * | Bootloader API Table | + * | (User App. Accessible) | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 8 + * | Bootloader ID Constants | + * | (User App. Accessible) | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND + * \endverbatim + * + * \subsection SSec_Aux_Space Auxiliary Bootloader Section + * To make the bootloader function on smaller devices (those with a physical + * bootloader section of smaller than 6KB) + * + * \section Sec_KnownIssues Known Issues: + * + * \par On Linux machines, the DFU bootloader is inaccessible. + * On many Linux systems, non-root users do not have automatic access to newly + * inserted DFU devices. Root privileges or a UDEV rule is required to gain + * access. + * See <a href=https://groups.google.com/d/msg/lufa-support/CP9cy2bc8yo/kBqsOu-RBeMJ>here</a> for resolution steps. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>SECURE_MODE</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>If defined to \c true, the bootloader will not accept any memory commands other than a chip erase on start-up, until an + * erase has been performed. This can be used in conjunction with the AVR's lockbits to prevent the AVRs firmware from + * being dumped by unauthorized persons. When false, all memory operations are allowed at any time.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3acf33c7ea --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define SECURE_MODE false + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..59ae519e4c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT + #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS + #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 32 + #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 + #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT + #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP + #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6b7b6d4900 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,185 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = PRODUCT_ID_CODE, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,0), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED, + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .DFU_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_DFU, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 0, + + .Class = 0xFE, + .SubClass = 0x01, + .Protocol = 0x02, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .DFU_Functional = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_DFU_Functional_t), .Type = DTYPE_DFUFunctional}, + + .Attributes = (ATTR_CAN_UPLOAD | ATTR_CAN_DOWNLOAD), + + .DetachTimeout = 0x0000, + .TransferSize = 0x0C00, + + .DFUSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0) + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"QMK"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"KB"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + if (DescriptorNumber == STRING_ID_Language) + { + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = LanguageString.Header.Size; + } + else if (DescriptorNumber == STRING_ID_Manufacturer) + { + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = ManufacturerString.Header.Size; + } + else if (DescriptorNumber == STRING_ID_Product) + { + Address = &ProductString; + Size = ProductString.Header.Size; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5487f88f35 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,194 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Descriptor type value for a DFU class functional descriptor. */ + #define DTYPE_DFUFunctional 0x21 + + /** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device will detach and re-attach when a DFU_DETACH + * command is issued, rather than the host issuing a USB Reset. + */ + #define ATTR_WILL_DETATCH (1 << 3) + + /** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device can communicate during the manifestation phase + * (memory programming phase). + */ + #define ATTR_MANEFESTATION_TOLLERANT (1 << 2) + + /** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device can accept DFU_UPLOAD requests to send data from + * the device to the host. + */ + #define ATTR_CAN_UPLOAD (1 << 1) + + /** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device can accept DFU_DNLOAD requests to send data from + * the host to the device. + */ + #define ATTR_CAN_DOWNLOAD (1 << 0) + + #if defined(__AVR_AT90USB1287__) + #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FFB + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x97 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 + #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB647__) + #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF9 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x96 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 + #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB1286__) + #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FFB + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x97 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 + #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB646__) + #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF9 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x96 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 + #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega32U4__) + #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF4 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x95 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x87 + #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega16U4__) + #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF3 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x94 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x88 + #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega32U2__) + #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF0 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x95 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x8A + #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega16U2__) + #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FEF + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x94 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x89 + #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB162__) + #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FFA + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x94 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 + #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega8U2__) + #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FEE + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x93 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x89 + #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB82__) + #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF7 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_1 0x1E + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_2 0x93 + #define AVR_SIGNATURE_3 0x82 + #else + #error The selected AVR part is not currently supported by this bootloader. + #endif + + #if !defined(PRODUCT_ID_CODE) + #error Current AVR model is not supported by this bootloader. + #endif + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a DFU class function descriptor. This descriptor gives DFU class information + * to the host when read, indicating the DFU device's capabilities. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Standard descriptor header structure */ + + uint8_t Attributes; /**< DFU device attributes, a mask comprising of the + * ATTR_* macros listed in this source file + */ + uint16_t DetachTimeout; /**< Timeout in milliseconds between a USB_DETACH + * command being issued and the device detaching + * from the USB bus + */ + uint16_t TransferSize; /**< Maximum number of bytes the DFU device can accept + * from the host in a transaction + */ + uint16_t DFUSpecification; /**< BCD packed DFU specification number this DFU + * device complies with + */ + } USB_Descriptor_DFU_Functional_t; + + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // DFU Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t DFU_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_DFU_Functional_t DFU_Functional; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_DFU = 0, /**< DFU interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6f3312b764 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,156 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="DFU Bootloader - 128KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.dfu.avr8.128_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_dfu_128kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.dfu"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x1F000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x1F000"/>
+
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x1FFA0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x1FFE0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x1FFF8"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="DFU Bootloader - 64KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.dfu.avr8.64_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_dfu_64kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.dfu"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb647"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0xF000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0xF000"/>
+
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0xFFA0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0xFFE0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0xFFF8"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="DFU Bootloader - 32KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.dfu.avr8.32_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_dfu_32kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.dfu"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u4"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x7000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x7000"/>
+
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x7FA0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x7FE0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x7FF8"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="DFU Bootloader - 16KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.dfu.avr8.16_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_dfu_16kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.dfu"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega16u2"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x3000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x3000"/>
+
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x3FA0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x3FE0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x3FF8"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="DFU Bootloader - 8KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.dfu.avr8.8_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_dfu_8kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.dfu"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega8u2"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x1000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x1000"/>
+
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x1FA0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x1FE0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x1FF8"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.bootloaders.dfu" caption="DFU Bootloader">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ DFU Class Bootloader, capable of reprogramming a device using the Atmel FLIP or other AVR DFU programming software when plugged into a host.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Bootloaders"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value="."/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="BootloaderDFU.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="BootloaderDFU.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="BootloaderAPI.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="BootloaderAPI.h"/>
+ <build type="asm-source" value="BootloaderAPITable.S"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="BootloaderDFU.txt"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cbb03d6fa9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2396 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - DFU Class Bootloader" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM \ + ATTR_NO_INIT + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/makefile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0d2014015d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = atmega32u4 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = QMK +F_CPU = 16000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = BootloaderDFU +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c BootloaderAPI.c BootloaderAPITable.S $(LUFA_SRC_USB) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ -DBOOT_START_ADDR=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET) +LD_FLAGS = -Wl,--section-start=.text=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET) $(BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS) + +# Flash size and bootloader section sizes of the target, in KB. These must +# match the target's total FLASH size and the bootloader size set in the +# device's fuses. +FLASH_SIZE_KB = 32 +BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB = 4 + +# Bootloader address calculation formulas +# Do not modify these macros, but rather modify the dependent values above. +CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX = $(shell printf "0x%X" $$(( $(1) )) ) +BOOT_START_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) - $(BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB)) * 1024 ) +BOOT_SEC_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) * 1024) - ($(strip $(1))) ) + +# Bootloader linker section flags for relocating the API table sections to +# known FLASH addresses - these should not normally be user-edited. +BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG = -Wl,--section-start=$(strip $(1))=$(call BOOT_SEC_OFFSET, $(3)) -Wl,--undefined=$(strip $(2)) +BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS = $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_trampolines, BootloaderAPI_Trampolines, 96) +BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS += $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_jumptable, BootloaderAPI_JumpTable, 32) +BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS += $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_signatures, BootloaderAPI_Signatures, 8) + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/BootloaderHID.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/BootloaderHID.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fa1dd5873e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/BootloaderHID.c @@ -0,0 +1,198 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the HID class bootloader. This file contains the complete bootloader logic. + */ + +#include "BootloaderHID.h" + +/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader should be running, or should exit and allow the application code to run + * via a soft reset. When cleared, the bootloader will abort, the USB interface will shut down and the application + * started via a forced watchdog reset. + */ +static bool RunBootloader = true; + +/** Magic lock for forced application start. If the HWBE fuse is programmed and BOOTRST is unprogrammed, the bootloader + * will start if the /HWB line of the AVR is held low and the system is reset. However, if the /HWB line is still held + * low when the application attempts to start via a watchdog reset, the bootloader will re-start. If set to the value + * \ref MAGIC_BOOT_KEY the special init function \ref Application_Jump_Check() will force the application to start. + */ +uint16_t MagicBootKey ATTR_NO_INIT; + + +/** Special startup routine to check if the bootloader was started via a watchdog reset, and if the magic application + * start key has been loaded into \ref MagicBootKey. If the bootloader started via the watchdog and the key is valid, + * this will force the user application to start via a software jump. + */ +void Application_Jump_Check(void) +{ + /* If the reset source was the bootloader and the key is correct, clear it and jump to the application */ + if ((MCUSR & (1 << WDRF)) && (MagicBootKey == MAGIC_BOOT_KEY)) + { + /* Turn off the watchdog */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Clear the boot key and jump to the user application */ + MagicBootKey = 0; + + // cppcheck-suppress constStatement + ((void (*)(void))0x0000)(); + } +} + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the bootloader, then continuously + * runs the bootloader processing routine until instructed to soft-exit. + */ +int main(void) +{ + /* Setup hardware required for the bootloader */ + SetupHardware(); + + /* Enable global interrupts so that the USB stack can function */ + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + while (RunBootloader) + USB_USBTask(); + + /* Disconnect from the host - USB interface will be reset later along with the AVR */ + USB_Detach(); + + /* Unlock the forced application start mode of the bootloader if it is restarted */ + MagicBootKey = MAGIC_BOOT_KEY; + + /* Enable the watchdog and force a timeout to reset the AVR */ + wdt_enable(WDTO_250MS); + + for (;;); +} + +/** Configures all hardware required for the bootloader. */ +static void SetupHardware(void) +{ + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); + + /* Relocate the interrupt vector table to the bootloader section */ + MCUCR = (1 << IVCE); + MCUCR = (1 << IVSEL); + + /* Initialize USB subsystem */ + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This configures the device's endpoints ready + * to relay data to and from the attached USB host. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + /* Setup HID Report Endpoint */ + Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(HID_IN_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, HID_IN_EPSIZE, 1); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to + * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing + * internally. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + /* Ignore any requests that aren't directed to the HID interface */ + if ((USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType & (CONTROL_REQTYPE_TYPE | CONTROL_REQTYPE_RECIPIENT)) != + (REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + return; + } + + /* Process HID specific control requests */ + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case HID_REQ_SetReport: + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Wait until the command has been sent by the host */ + while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())); + + /* Read in the write destination address */ + #if (FLASHEND > 0xFFFF) + uint32_t PageAddress = ((uint32_t)Endpoint_Read_16_LE() << 8); + #else + uint16_t PageAddress = Endpoint_Read_16_LE(); + #endif + + /* Check if the command is a program page command, or a start application command */ + #if (FLASHEND > 0xFFFF) + if ((uint16_t)(PageAddress >> 8) == COMMAND_STARTAPPLICATION) + #else + if (PageAddress == COMMAND_STARTAPPLICATION) + #endif + { + RunBootloader = false; + } + else if (PageAddress < BOOT_START_ADDR) + { + /* Erase the given FLASH page, ready to be programmed */ + boot_page_erase(PageAddress); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + + /* Write each of the FLASH page's bytes in sequence */ + for (uint8_t PageWord = 0; PageWord < (SPM_PAGESIZE / 2); PageWord++) + { + /* Check if endpoint is empty - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */ + if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint())) + { + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())); + } + + /* Write the next data word to the FLASH page */ + boot_page_fill(PageAddress + ((uint16_t)PageWord << 1), Endpoint_Read_16_LE()); + } + + /* Write the filled FLASH page to memory */ + boot_page_write(PageAddress); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + + /* Re-enable RWW section */ + boot_rww_enable(); + } + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + break; + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/BootloaderHID.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/BootloaderHID.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..62ee07de30 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/BootloaderHID.h @@ -0,0 +1,71 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for BootloaderHID.c. + */ + +#ifndef _BOOTLOADERHID_H_ +#define _BOOTLOADERHID_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/boot.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__OPTIMIZE_SIZE__) + #error This bootloader requires that it be optimized for size, not speed, to fit into the target device. Change optimization settings and try again. + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** Bootloader special address to start the user application */ + #define COMMAND_STARTAPPLICATION 0xFFFF + + /** Magic bootloader key to unlock forced application start mode. */ + #define MAGIC_BOOT_KEY 0xDC42 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + static void SetupHardware(void); + + void Application_Jump_Check(void) ATTR_INIT_SECTION(3); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/BootloaderHID.txt b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/BootloaderHID.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e340703c41 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/BootloaderHID.txt @@ -0,0 +1,105 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage HID Class USB AVR Bootloader + * + * \section SSec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * + * \section SSec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device Class (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Class Standard \n + * Teensy Programming Protocol Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section SSec_Description Project Description: + * + * This bootloader enumerates to the host as a HID Class device, allowing for device FLASH programming through + * the supplied command line software, which is a modified version of Paul's TeensyHID Command Line loader code + * from PJRC (used with permission). This bootloader is deliberately non-compatible with the proprietary PJRC + * HalfKay bootloader GUI; only the command line interface software accompanying this bootloader will work with it. + * + * Out of the box this bootloader builds for the AT90USB1287 with an 8KB bootloader section size, and will fit + * into 2KB of bootloader space for the Series 2 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU2, AT90USBxx2) or 4KB of bootloader space for + * all other models. If you wish to alter this size and/or change the AVR model, you will need to edit the MCU, + * FLASH_SIZE_KB and BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB values in the accompanying makefile. + * + * \warning <b>THIS BOOTLOADER IS NOT SECURE.</b> Malicious entities can recover written data, even if the device + * lockbits are set. + * + * \section Sec_Running Running the Bootloader + * + * This bootloader is designed to be started via the \c HWB mechanism of the USB AVRs; ground the \c HWB pin (see device + * datasheet) then momentarily ground \c /RESET to start the bootloader. This assumes the \c HWBE fuse is set and the + * \c BOOTRST fuse is cleared. + * + * \section Sec_Installation Driver Installation + * + * This bootloader uses the HID class driver inbuilt into all modern operating systems, thus no additional drivers + * need to be supplied for correct operation. + * + * \section Sec_HostApp Host Controller Application + * + * Due to licensing issues, the supplied bootloader is compatible with the HalfKay bootloader protocol designed + * by PJRC, but is <b>not compatible with the cross-platform loader GUI</b>. A modified version of the open source + * cross-platform TeensyLoader application is supplied, which can be compiled under most operating systems. The + * command-line loader application should remain compatible with genuine Teensy boards in addition to boards using + * this custom bootloader. + * + * Once compiled, programs can be loaded into the AVR's FLASH memory through the following example command: + * \code + * hid_bootloader_cli -mmcu=at90usb1287 Mouse.hex + * \endcode + * + * \section Sec_KnownIssues Known Issues: + * + * \par After loading an application, it is not run automatically on startup. + * Some USB AVR boards ship with the \c BOOTRST fuse set, causing the bootloader + * to run automatically when the device is reset. This booloader requires the + * \c BOOTRST be disabled and the HWBE fuse used instead to run the bootloader + * when needed. + * + * \section SSec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5aa0e765bf --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT + #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS + #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 + #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT + #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP + #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..854ae1b636 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,187 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the + * USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This + * descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding) + * the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for + * more details on HID report descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t HIDReport[] = +{ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(16, 0xFFDC), /* Vendor Page 0xDC */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0xFB), /* Vendor Usage 0xFB */ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x01), /* Vendor Usage 1 */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x02), /* Vendor Usage 2 */ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 0xFF), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x08), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(16, (sizeof(uint16_t) + SPM_PAGESIZE)), + HID_RI_OUTPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE | HID_IOF_NON_VOLATILE), + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0), +}; + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2067, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + .ProductStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED, + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .HID_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_GenericHID, + .AlternateSetting = 0x00, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_NonBootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_NonBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID_VendorHID = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(HIDReport) + }, + + .HID_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = HID_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = HID_IN_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, +}; + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + /* If/Else If chain compiles slightly smaller than a switch case */ + if (DescriptorType == DTYPE_Device) + { + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + } + else if (DescriptorType == DTYPE_Configuration) + { + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + } + else if (DescriptorType == HID_DTYPE_HID) + { + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID_VendorHID; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + } + else if (DescriptorType == HID_DTYPE_Report) + { + Address = &HIDReport; + Size = sizeof(HIDReport); + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5516b16354 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,80 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Generic HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID_Interface; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID_VendorHID; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID_ReportINEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_GenericHID = 0, /**< GenericHID interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the HID data IN endpoint. */ + #define HID_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Size in bytes of the HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define HID_IN_EPSIZE 64 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/.gitignore b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/.gitignore new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4e73d1ec5b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/.gitignore @@ -0,0 +1 @@ +hid_bootloader_cli diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/Makefile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/Makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d7d6458a5c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/Makefile @@ -0,0 +1,40 @@ +OS ?= LINUX +#OS ?= WINDOWS +#OS ?= MACOSX +#OS ?= BSD + +ifeq ($(OS), LINUX) # also works on FreeBSD +CC ?= gcc +CFLAGS ?= -O2 -Wall +hid_bootloader_cli: hid_bootloader_cli.c + $(CC) $(CFLAGS) -s -DUSE_LIBUSB -o hid_bootloader_cli hid_bootloader_cli.c -lusb + + +else ifeq ($(OS), WINDOWS) +CC = i586-mingw32msvc-gcc +CFLAGS ?= -O2 -Wall +LDLIB = -lsetupapi -lhid +hid_bootloader_cli.exe: hid_bootloader_cli.c + $(CC) $(CFLAGS) -s -DUSE_WIN32 -o hid_bootloader_cli.exe hid_bootloader_cli.c $(LDLIB) + + +else ifeq ($(OS), MACOSX) +CC ?= gcc +SDK ?= /Developer/SDKs/MacOSX10.5.sdk +CFLAGS ?= -O2 -Wall +hid_bootloader_cli: hid_bootloader_cli.c + $(CC) $(CFLAGS) -DUSE_APPLE_IOKIT -isysroot $(SDK) -o hid_bootloader_cli hid_bootloader_cli.c -Wl,-syslibroot,$(SDK) -framework IOKit -framework CoreFoundation + + +else ifeq ($(OS), BSD) # works on NetBSD and OpenBSD +CC ?= gcct +CFLAGS ?= -O2 -Wall +hid_bootloader_cli: hid_bootloader_cli.c + $(CC) $(CFLAGS) -s -DUSE_UHID -o hid_bootloader_cli hid_bootloader_cli.c + + +endif + + +clean: + rm -f hid_bootloader_cli hid_bootloader_cli.exe diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/Makefile.bsd b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/Makefile.bsd new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a15a664053 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/Makefile.bsd @@ -0,0 +1,21 @@ +OS ?= FreeBSD +#OS ?= NetBSD +#OS ?= OpenBSD + +CFLAGS ?= -O2 -Wall +CC ?= gcc + +.if $(OS) == "FreeBSD" +CFLAGS += -DUSE_LIBUSB +LIBS = -lusb +.elif $(OS) == "NetBSD" || $(OS) == "OpenBSD" +CFLAGS += -DUSE_UHID +LIBS = +.endif + + +hid_bootloader_cli: hid_bootloader_cli.c + $(CC) $(CFLAGS) -s -o hid_bootloader_cli hid_bootloader_cli.c $(LIBS) + +clean: + rm -f hid_bootloader_cli diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/gpl3.txt b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/gpl3.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..94a9ed024d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/gpl3.txt @@ -0,0 +1,674 @@ + GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE + Version 3, 29 June 2007 + + Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/> + Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies + of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. + + Preamble + + The GNU General Public License is a free, copyleft license for +software and other kinds of works. + + The licenses for most software and other practical works are designed +to take away your freedom to share and change the works. By contrast, +the GNU General Public License is intended to guarantee your freedom to +share and change all versions of a program--to make sure it remains free +software for all its users. We, the Free Software Foundation, use the +GNU General Public License for most of our software; it applies also to +any other work released this way by its authors. You can apply it to +your programs, too. + + When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not +price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you +have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for +them if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you +want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new +free programs, and that you know you can do these things. + + To protect your rights, we need to prevent others from denying you +these rights or asking you to surrender the rights. Therefore, you have +certain responsibilities if you distribute copies of the software, or if +you modify it: responsibilities to respect the freedom of others. + + For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether +gratis or for a fee, you must pass on to the recipients the same +freedoms that you received. You must make sure that they, too, receive +or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so they +know their rights. + + Developers that use the GNU GPL protect your rights with two steps: +(1) assert copyright on the software, and (2) offer you this License +giving you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify it. + + For the developers' and authors' protection, the GPL clearly explains +that there is no warranty for this free software. For both users' and +authors' sake, the GPL requires that modified versions be marked as +changed, so that their problems will not be attributed erroneously to +authors of previous versions. + + Some devices are designed to deny users access to install or run +modified versions of the software inside them, although the manufacturer +can do so. This is fundamentally incompatible with the aim of +protecting users' freedom to change the software. The systematic +pattern of such abuse occurs in the area of products for individuals to +use, which is precisely where it is most unacceptable. Therefore, we +have designed this version of the GPL to prohibit the practice for those +products. If such problems arise substantially in other domains, we +stand ready to extend this provision to those domains in future versions +of the GPL, as needed to protect the freedom of users. + + Finally, every program is threatened constantly by software patents. +States should not allow patents to restrict development and use of +software on general-purpose computers, but in those that do, we wish to +avoid the special danger that patents applied to a free program could +make it effectively proprietary. To prevent this, the GPL assures that +patents cannot be used to render the program non-free. + + The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and +modification follow. + + TERMS AND CONDITIONS + + 0. Definitions. + + "This License" refers to version 3 of the GNU General Public License. + + "Copyright" also means copyright-like laws that apply to other kinds of +works, such as semiconductor masks. + + "The Program" refers to any copyrightable work licensed under this +License. Each licensee is addressed as "you". "Licensees" and +"recipients" may be individuals or organizations. + + To "modify" a work means to copy from or adapt all or part of the work +in a fashion requiring copyright permission, other than the making of an +exact copy. The resulting work is called a "modified version" of the +earlier work or a work "based on" the earlier work. + + A "covered work" means either the unmodified Program or a work based +on the Program. + + To "propagate" a work means to do anything with it that, without +permission, would make you directly or secondarily liable for +infringement under applicable copyright law, except executing it on a +computer or modifying a private copy. Propagation includes copying, +distribution (with or without modification), making available to the +public, and in some countries other activities as well. + + To "convey" a work means any kind of propagation that enables other +parties to make or receive copies. Mere interaction with a user through +a computer network, with no transfer of a copy, is not conveying. + + An interactive user interface displays "Appropriate Legal Notices" +to the extent that it includes a convenient and prominently visible +feature that (1) displays an appropriate copyright notice, and (2) +tells the user that there is no warranty for the work (except to the +extent that warranties are provided), that licensees may convey the +work under this License, and how to view a copy of this License. If +the interface presents a list of user commands or options, such as a +menu, a prominent item in the list meets this criterion. + + 1. Source Code. + + The "source code" for a work means the preferred form of the work +for making modifications to it. "Object code" means any non-source +form of a work. + + A "Standard Interface" means an interface that either is an official +standard defined by a recognized standards body, or, in the case of +interfaces specified for a particular programming language, one that +is widely used among developers working in that language. + + The "System Libraries" of an executable work include anything, other +than the work as a whole, that (a) is included in the normal form of +packaging a Major Component, but which is not part of that Major +Component, and (b) serves only to enable use of the work with that +Major Component, or to implement a Standard Interface for which an +implementation is available to the public in source code form. A +"Major Component", in this context, means a major essential component +(kernel, window system, and so on) of the specific operating system +(if any) on which the executable work runs, or a compiler used to +produce the work, or an object code interpreter used to run it. + + The "Corresponding Source" for a work in object code form means all +the source code needed to generate, install, and (for an executable +work) run the object code and to modify the work, including scripts to +control those activities. However, it does not include the work's +System Libraries, or general-purpose tools or generally available free +programs which are used unmodified in performing those activities but +which are not part of the work. For example, Corresponding Source +includes interface definition files associated with source files for +the work, and the source code for shared libraries and dynamically +linked subprograms that the work is specifically designed to require, +such as by intimate data communication or control flow between those +subprograms and other parts of the work. + + The Corresponding Source need not include anything that users +can regenerate automatically from other parts of the Corresponding +Source. + + The Corresponding Source for a work in source code form is that +same work. + + 2. Basic Permissions. + + All rights granted under this License are granted for the term of +copyright on the Program, and are irrevocable provided the stated +conditions are met. This License explicitly affirms your unlimited +permission to run the unmodified Program. The output from running a +covered work is covered by this License only if the output, given its +content, constitutes a covered work. This License acknowledges your +rights of fair use or other equivalent, as provided by copyright law. + + You may make, run and propagate covered works that you do not +convey, without conditions so long as your license otherwise remains +in force. You may convey covered works to others for the sole purpose +of having them make modifications exclusively for you, or provide you +with facilities for running those works, provided that you comply with +the terms of this License in conveying all material for which you do +not control copyright. Those thus making or running the covered works +for you must do so exclusively on your behalf, under your direction +and control, on terms that prohibit them from making any copies of +your copyrighted material outside their relationship with you. + + Conveying under any other circumstances is permitted solely under +the conditions stated below. Sublicensing is not allowed; section 10 +makes it unnecessary. + + 3. Protecting Users' Legal Rights From Anti-Circumvention Law. + + No covered work shall be deemed part of an effective technological +measure under any applicable law fulfilling obligations under article +11 of the WIPO copyright treaty adopted on 20 December 1996, or +similar laws prohibiting or restricting circumvention of such +measures. + + When you convey a covered work, you waive any legal power to forbid +circumvention of technological measures to the extent such circumvention +is effected by exercising rights under this License with respect to +the covered work, and you disclaim any intention to limit operation or +modification of the work as a means of enforcing, against the work's +users, your or third parties' legal rights to forbid circumvention of +technological measures. + + 4. Conveying Verbatim Copies. + + You may convey verbatim copies of the Program's source code as you +receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and +appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice; +keep intact all notices stating that this License and any +non-permissive terms added in accord with section 7 apply to the code; +keep intact all notices of the absence of any warranty; and give all +recipients a copy of this License along with the Program. + + You may charge any price or no price for each copy that you convey, +and you may offer support or warranty protection for a fee. + + 5. Conveying Modified Source Versions. + + You may convey a work based on the Program, or the modifications to +produce it from the Program, in the form of source code under the +terms of section 4, provided that you also meet all of these conditions: + + a) The work must carry prominent notices stating that you modified + it, and giving a relevant date. + + b) The work must carry prominent notices stating that it is + released under this License and any conditions added under section + 7. This requirement modifies the requirement in section 4 to + "keep intact all notices". + + c) You must license the entire work, as a whole, under this + License to anyone who comes into possession of a copy. This + License will therefore apply, along with any applicable section 7 + additional terms, to the whole of the work, and all its parts, + regardless of how they are packaged. This License gives no + permission to license the work in any other way, but it does not + invalidate such permission if you have separately received it. + + d) If the work has interactive user interfaces, each must display + Appropriate Legal Notices; however, if the Program has interactive + interfaces that do not display Appropriate Legal Notices, your + work need not make them do so. + + A compilation of a covered work with other separate and independent +works, which are not by their nature extensions of the covered work, +and which are not combined with it such as to form a larger program, +in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an +"aggregate" if the compilation and its resulting copyright are not +used to limit the access or legal rights of the compilation's users +beyond what the individual works permit. Inclusion of a covered work +in an aggregate does not cause this License to apply to the other +parts of the aggregate. + + 6. Conveying Non-Source Forms. + + You may convey a covered work in object code form under the terms +of sections 4 and 5, provided that you also convey the +machine-readable Corresponding Source under the terms of this License, +in one of these ways: + + a) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product + (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by the + Corresponding Source fixed on a durable physical medium + customarily used for software interchange. + + b) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product + (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by a + written offer, valid for at least three years and valid for as + long as you offer spare parts or customer support for that product + model, to give anyone who possesses the object code either (1) a + copy of the Corresponding Source for all the software in the + product that is covered by this License, on a durable physical + medium customarily used for software interchange, for a price no + more than your reasonable cost of physically performing this + conveying of source, or (2) access to copy the + Corresponding Source from a network server at no charge. + + c) Convey individual copies of the object code with a copy of the + written offer to provide the Corresponding Source. This + alternative is allowed only occasionally and noncommercially, and + only if you received the object code with such an offer, in accord + with subsection 6b. + + d) Convey the object code by offering access from a designated + place (gratis or for a charge), and offer equivalent access to the + Corresponding Source in the same way through the same place at no + further charge. You need not require recipients to copy the + Corresponding Source along with the object code. If the place to + copy the object code is a network server, the Corresponding Source + may be on a different server (operated by you or a third party) + that supports equivalent copying facilities, provided you maintain + clear directions next to the object code saying where to find the + Corresponding Source. Regardless of what server hosts the + Corresponding Source, you remain obligated to ensure that it is + available for as long as needed to satisfy these requirements. + + e) Convey the object code using peer-to-peer transmission, provided + you inform other peers where the object code and Corresponding + Source of the work are being offered to the general public at no + charge under subsection 6d. + + A separable portion of the object code, whose source code is excluded +from the Corresponding Source as a System Library, need not be +included in conveying the object code work. + + A "User Product" is either (1) a "consumer product", which means any +tangible personal property which is normally used for personal, family, +or household purposes, or (2) anything designed or sold for incorporation +into a dwelling. In determining whether a product is a consumer product, +doubtful cases shall be resolved in favor of coverage. For a particular +product received by a particular user, "normally used" refers to a +typical or common use of that class of product, regardless of the status +of the particular user or of the way in which the particular user +actually uses, or expects or is expected to use, the product. A product +is a consumer product regardless of whether the product has substantial +commercial, industrial or non-consumer uses, unless such uses represent +the only significant mode of use of the product. + + "Installation Information" for a User Product means any methods, +procedures, authorization keys, or other information required to install +and execute modified versions of a covered work in that User Product from +a modified version of its Corresponding Source. The information must +suffice to ensure that the continued functioning of the modified object +code is in no case prevented or interfered with solely because +modification has been made. + + If you convey an object code work under this section in, or with, or +specifically for use in, a User Product, and the conveying occurs as +part of a transaction in which the right of possession and use of the +User Product is transferred to the recipient in perpetuity or for a +fixed term (regardless of how the transaction is characterized), the +Corresponding Source conveyed under this section must be accompanied +by the Installation Information. But this requirement does not apply +if neither you nor any third party retains the ability to install +modified object code on the User Product (for example, the work has +been installed in ROM). + + The requirement to provide Installation Information does not include a +requirement to continue to provide support service, warranty, or updates +for a work that has been modified or installed by the recipient, or for +the User Product in which it has been modified or installed. Access to a +network may be denied when the modification itself materially and +adversely affects the operation of the network or violates the rules and +protocols for communication across the network. + + Corresponding Source conveyed, and Installation Information provided, +in accord with this section must be in a format that is publicly +documented (and with an implementation available to the public in +source code form), and must require no special password or key for +unpacking, reading or copying. + + 7. Additional Terms. + + "Additional permissions" are terms that supplement the terms of this +License by making exceptions from one or more of its conditions. +Additional permissions that are applicable to the entire Program shall +be treated as though they were included in this License, to the extent +that they are valid under applicable law. If additional permissions +apply only to part of the Program, that part may be used separately +under those permissions, but the entire Program remains governed by +this License without regard to the additional permissions. + + When you convey a copy of a covered work, you may at your option +remove any additional permissions from that copy, or from any part of +it. (Additional permissions may be written to require their own +removal in certain cases when you modify the work.) You may place +additional permissions on material, added by you to a covered work, +for which you have or can give appropriate copyright permission. + + Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, for material you +add to a covered work, you may (if authorized by the copyright holders of +that material) supplement the terms of this License with terms: + + a) Disclaiming warranty or limiting liability differently from the + terms of sections 15 and 16 of this License; or + + b) Requiring preservation of specified reasonable legal notices or + author attributions in that material or in the Appropriate Legal + Notices displayed by works containing it; or + + c) Prohibiting misrepresentation of the origin of that material, or + requiring that modified versions of such material be marked in + reasonable ways as different from the original version; or + + d) Limiting the use for publicity purposes of names of licensors or + authors of the material; or + + e) Declining to grant rights under trademark law for use of some + trade names, trademarks, or service marks; or + + f) Requiring indemnification of licensors and authors of that + material by anyone who conveys the material (or modified versions of + it) with contractual assumptions of liability to the recipient, for + any liability that these contractual assumptions directly impose on + those licensors and authors. + + All other non-permissive additional terms are considered "further +restrictions" within the meaning of section 10. If the Program as you +received it, or any part of it, contains a notice stating that it is +governed by this License along with a term that is a further +restriction, you may remove that term. If a license document contains +a further restriction but permits relicensing or conveying under this +License, you may add to a covered work material governed by the terms +of that license document, provided that the further restriction does +not survive such relicensing or conveying. + + If you add terms to a covered work in accord with this section, you +must place, in the relevant source files, a statement of the +additional terms that apply to those files, or a notice indicating +where to find the applicable terms. + + Additional terms, permissive or non-permissive, may be stated in the +form of a separately written license, or stated as exceptions; +the above requirements apply either way. + + 8. Termination. + + You may not propagate or modify a covered work except as expressly +provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to propagate or +modify it is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under +this License (including any patent licenses granted under the third +paragraph of section 11). + + However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your +license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a) +provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and +finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright +holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means +prior to 60 days after the cessation. + + Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is +reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the +violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have +received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that +copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after +your receipt of the notice. + + Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the +licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under +this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently +reinstated, you do not qualify to receive new licenses for the same +material under section 10. + + 9. Acceptance Not Required for Having Copies. + + You are not required to accept this License in order to receive or +run a copy of the Program. Ancillary propagation of a covered work +occurring solely as a consequence of using peer-to-peer transmission +to receive a copy likewise does not require acceptance. However, +nothing other than this License grants you permission to propagate or +modify any covered work. These actions infringe copyright if you do +not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or propagating a +covered work, you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so. + + 10. Automatic Licensing of Downstream Recipients. + + Each time you convey a covered work, the recipient automatically +receives a license from the original licensors, to run, modify and +propagate that work, subject to this License. You are not responsible +for enforcing compliance by third parties with this License. + + An "entity transaction" is a transaction transferring control of an +organization, or substantially all assets of one, or subdividing an +organization, or merging organizations. If propagation of a covered +work results from an entity transaction, each party to that +transaction who receives a copy of the work also receives whatever +licenses to the work the party's predecessor in interest had or could +give under the previous paragraph, plus a right to possession of the +Corresponding Source of the work from the predecessor in interest, if +the predecessor has it or can get it with reasonable efforts. + + You may not impose any further restrictions on the exercise of the +rights granted or affirmed under this License. For example, you may +not impose a license fee, royalty, or other charge for exercise of +rights granted under this License, and you may not initiate litigation +(including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that +any patent claim is infringed by making, using, selling, offering for +sale, or importing the Program or any portion of it. + + 11. Patents. + + A "contributor" is a copyright holder who authorizes use under this +License of the Program or a work on which the Program is based. The +work thus licensed is called the contributor's "contributor version". + + A contributor's "essential patent claims" are all patent claims +owned or controlled by the contributor, whether already acquired or +hereafter acquired, that would be infringed by some manner, permitted +by this License, of making, using, or selling its contributor version, +but do not include claims that would be infringed only as a +consequence of further modification of the contributor version. For +purposes of this definition, "control" includes the right to grant +patent sublicenses in a manner consistent with the requirements of +this License. + + Each contributor grants you a non-exclusive, worldwide, royalty-free +patent license under the contributor's essential patent claims, to +make, use, sell, offer for sale, import and otherwise run, modify and +propagate the contents of its contributor version. + + In the following three paragraphs, a "patent license" is any express +agreement or commitment, however denominated, not to enforce a patent +(such as an express permission to practice a patent or covenant not to +sue for patent infringement). To "grant" such a patent license to a +party means to make such an agreement or commitment not to enforce a +patent against the party. + + If you convey a covered work, knowingly relying on a patent license, +and the Corresponding Source of the work is not available for anyone +to copy, free of charge and under the terms of this License, through a +publicly available network server or other readily accessible means, +then you must either (1) cause the Corresponding Source to be so +available, or (2) arrange to deprive yourself of the benefit of the +patent license for this particular work, or (3) arrange, in a manner +consistent with the requirements of this License, to extend the patent +license to downstream recipients. "Knowingly relying" means you have +actual knowledge that, but for the patent license, your conveying the +covered work in a country, or your recipient's use of the covered work +in a country, would infringe one or more identifiable patents in that +country that you have reason to believe are valid. + + If, pursuant to or in connection with a single transaction or +arrangement, you convey, or propagate by procuring conveyance of, a +covered work, and grant a patent license to some of the parties +receiving the covered work authorizing them to use, propagate, modify +or convey a specific copy of the covered work, then the patent license +you grant is automatically extended to all recipients of the covered +work and works based on it. + + A patent license is "discriminatory" if it does not include within +the scope of its coverage, prohibits the exercise of, or is +conditioned on the non-exercise of one or more of the rights that are +specifically granted under this License. You may not convey a covered +work if you are a party to an arrangement with a third party that is +in the business of distributing software, under which you make payment +to the third party based on the extent of your activity of conveying +the work, and under which the third party grants, to any of the +parties who would receive the covered work from you, a discriminatory +patent license (a) in connection with copies of the covered work +conveyed by you (or copies made from those copies), or (b) primarily +for and in connection with specific products or compilations that +contain the covered work, unless you entered into that arrangement, +or that patent license was granted, prior to 28 March 2007. + + Nothing in this License shall be construed as excluding or limiting +any implied license or other defenses to infringement that may +otherwise be available to you under applicable patent law. + + 12. No Surrender of Others' Freedom. + + If conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or +otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not +excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot convey a +covered work so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this +License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may +not convey it at all. For example, if you agree to terms that obligate you +to collect a royalty for further conveying from those to whom you convey +the Program, the only way you could satisfy both those terms and this +License would be to refrain entirely from conveying the Program. + + 13. Use with the GNU Affero General Public License. + + Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, you have +permission to link or combine any covered work with a work licensed +under version 3 of the GNU Affero General Public License into a single +combined work, and to convey the resulting work. The terms of this +License will continue to apply to the part which is the covered work, +but the special requirements of the GNU Affero General Public License, +section 13, concerning interaction through a network will apply to the +combination as such. + + 14. Revised Versions of this License. + + The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of +the GNU General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will +be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to +address new problems or concerns. + + Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the +Program specifies that a certain numbered version of the GNU General +Public License "or any later version" applies to it, you have the +option of following the terms and conditions either of that numbered +version or of any later version published by the Free Software +Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of the +GNU General Public License, you may choose any version ever published +by the Free Software Foundation. + + If the Program specifies that a proxy can decide which future +versions of the GNU General Public License can be used, that proxy's +public statement of acceptance of a version permanently authorizes you +to choose that version for the Program. + + Later license versions may give you additional or different +permissions. However, no additional obligations are imposed on any +author or copyright holder as a result of your choosing to follow a +later version. + + 15. Disclaimer of Warranty. + + THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY +APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT +HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY +OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, +THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR +PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM +IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF +ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION. + + 16. Limitation of Liability. + + IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING +WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MODIFIES AND/OR CONVEYS +THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY +GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE +USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF +DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD +PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), +EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF +SUCH DAMAGES. + + 17. Interpretation of Sections 15 and 16. + + If the disclaimer of warranty and limitation of liability provided +above cannot be given local legal effect according to their terms, +reviewing courts shall apply local law that most closely approximates +an absolute waiver of all civil liability in connection with the +Program, unless a warranty or assumption of liability accompanies a +copy of the Program in return for a fee. + + END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS + + How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs + + If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest +possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it +free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms. + + To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest +to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively +state the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least +the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found. + + <one line to give the program's name and a brief idea of what it does.> + Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> + + This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify + it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by + the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or + (at your option) any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the + GNU General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License + along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. + +Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail. + + If the program does terminal interaction, make it output a short +notice like this when it starts in an interactive mode: + + <program> Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> + This program comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show w'. + This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it + under certain conditions; type `show c' for details. + +The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should show the appropriate +parts of the General Public License. Of course, your program's commands +might be different; for a GUI interface, you would use an "about box". + + You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or school, +if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the program, if necessary. +For more information on this, and how to apply and follow the GNU GPL, see +<http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. + + The GNU General Public License does not permit incorporating your program +into proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you +may consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with +the library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General +Public License instead of this License. But first, please read +<http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/why-not-lgpl.html>. diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/hid_bootloader_cli.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/hid_bootloader_cli.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b54f943b1c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp/hid_bootloader_cli.c @@ -0,0 +1,1013 @@ +/* Modified for the LUFA HID Bootloader by Dean Camera + * http://www.lufa-lib.org + * + * THIS MODIFIED VERSION IS UNSUPPORTED BY PJRC. + */ + +/* Teensy Loader, Command Line Interface + * Program and Reboot Teensy Board with HalfKay Bootloader + * http://www.pjrc.com/teensy/loader_cli.html + * Copyright 2008-2010, PJRC.COM, LLC + * + * + * You may redistribute this program and/or modify it under the terms + * of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software + * Foundation, version 3 of the License. + * + * This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the + * GNU General Public License for more details. + * + * You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License + * along with this program. If not, see http://www.gnu.org/licenses/ + */ + +/* Want to incorporate this code into a proprietary application?? + * Just email paul@pjrc.com to ask. Usually it's not a problem, + * but you do need to ask to use this code in any way other than + * those permitted by the GNU General Public License, version 3 */ + +/* For non-root permissions on ubuntu or similar udev-based linux + * http://www.pjrc.com/teensy/49-teensy.rules + */ + +#include <stdio.h> +#include <stdlib.h> +#include <stdint.h> +#include <stdarg.h> +#include <string.h> +#include <unistd.h> + +void usage(void) +{ + fprintf(stderr, "Usage: hid_bootloader_cli -mmcu=<MCU> [-w] [-h] [-n] [-v] <file.hex>\n"); + fprintf(stderr, "\t-w : Wait for device to appear\n"); + fprintf(stderr, "\t-r : Use hard reboot if device not online\n"); + fprintf(stderr, "\t-n : No reboot after programming\n"); + fprintf(stderr, "\t-v : Verbose output\n"); + fprintf(stderr, "\n<MCU> = atmegaXXuY or at90usbXXXY"); + + fprintf(stderr, "\nFor support and more information, please visit:\n"); + fprintf(stderr, "http://www.lufa-lib.org\n"); + + fprintf(stderr, "\nBased on the TeensyHID command line programmer software:\n"); + fprintf(stderr, "http://www.pjrc.com/teensy/loader_cli.html\n"); + exit(1); +} + +// USB Access Functions +int teensy_open(void); +int teensy_write(void *buf, int len, double timeout); +void teensy_close(void); +int hard_reboot(void); + +// Intel Hex File Functions +int read_intel_hex(const char *filename); +int ihex_bytes_within_range(int begin, int end); +void ihex_get_data(int addr, int len, unsigned char *bytes); + +// Misc stuff +int printf_verbose(const char *format, ...); +void delay(double seconds); +void die(const char *str, ...); +void parse_options(int argc, char **argv); + +// options (from user via command line args) +int wait_for_device_to_appear = 0; +int hard_reboot_device = 0; +int reboot_after_programming = 1; +int verbose = 0; +int code_size = 0, block_size = 0; +const char *filename=NULL; + + +/****************************************************************/ +/* */ +/* Main Program */ +/* */ +/****************************************************************/ + +int main(int argc, char **argv) +{ + unsigned char buf[260]; + int num, addr, r, first_block=1, waited=0; + + // parse command line arguments + parse_options(argc, argv); + if (!filename) { + fprintf(stderr, "Filename must be specified\n\n"); + usage(); + } + if (!code_size) { + fprintf(stderr, "MCU type must be specified\n\n"); + usage(); + } + printf_verbose("Teensy Loader, Command Line, Version 2.0\n"); + + // read the intel hex file + // this is done first so any error is reported before using USB + num = read_intel_hex(filename); + if (num < 0) die("error reading intel hex file \"%s\"", filename); + printf_verbose("Read \"%s\": %d bytes, %.1f%% usage\n", + filename, num, (double)num / (double)code_size * 100.0); + + // open the USB device + while (1) { + if (teensy_open()) break; + if (hard_reboot_device) { + if (!hard_reboot()) die("Unable to find rebootor\n"); + printf_verbose("Hard Reboot performed\n"); + hard_reboot_device = 0; // only hard reboot once + wait_for_device_to_appear = 1; + } + if (!wait_for_device_to_appear) die("Unable to open device\n"); + if (!waited) { + printf_verbose("Waiting for Teensy device...\n"); + printf_verbose(" (hint: press the reset button)\n"); + waited = 1; + } + delay(0.25); + } + printf_verbose("Found HalfKay Bootloader\n"); + + // if we waited for the device, read the hex file again + // perhaps it changed while we were waiting? + if (waited) { + num = read_intel_hex(filename); + if (num < 0) die("error reading intel hex file \"%s\"", filename); + printf_verbose("Read \"%s\": %d bytes, %.1f%% usage\n", + filename, num, (double)num / (double)code_size * 100.0); + } + + // program the data + printf_verbose("Programming"); + fflush(stdout); + for (addr = 0; addr < code_size; addr += block_size) { + if (addr > 0 && !ihex_bytes_within_range(addr, addr + block_size - 1)) { + // don't waste time on blocks that are unused, + // but always do the first one to erase the chip + continue; + } + printf_verbose("."); + if (code_size < 0x10000) { + buf[0] = addr & 255; + buf[1] = (addr >> 8) & 255; + } else { + buf[0] = (addr >> 8) & 255; + buf[1] = (addr >> 16) & 255; + } + ihex_get_data(addr, block_size, buf + 2); + r = teensy_write(buf, block_size + 2, first_block ? 3.0 : 0.25); + if (!r) die("error writing to Teensy\n"); + first_block = 0; + } + printf_verbose("\n"); + + // reboot to the user's new code + if (reboot_after_programming) { + printf_verbose("Booting\n"); + buf[0] = 0xFF; + buf[1] = 0xFF; + memset(buf + 2, 0, sizeof(buf) - 2); + teensy_write(buf, block_size + 2, 0.25); + } + teensy_close(); + return 0; +} + + + + +/****************************************************************/ +/* */ +/* USB Access - libusb (Linux & FreeBSD) */ +/* */ +/****************************************************************/ + +#if defined(USE_LIBUSB) + +// http://libusb.sourceforge.net/doc/index.html +#include <usb.h> + +usb_dev_handle * open_usb_device(int vid, int pid) +{ + struct usb_bus *bus; + struct usb_device *dev; + usb_dev_handle *h; + #ifdef LIBUSB_HAS_GET_DRIVER_NP + char buf[128]; + #endif + int r; + + usb_init(); + usb_find_busses(); + usb_find_devices(); + //printf_verbose("\nSearching for USB device:\n"); + for (bus = usb_get_busses(); bus; bus = bus->next) { + for (dev = bus->devices; dev; dev = dev->next) { + //printf_verbose("bus \"%s\", device \"%s\" vid=%04X, pid=%04X\n", + // bus->dirname, dev->filename, + // dev->descriptor.idVendor, + // dev->descriptor.idProduct + //); + if (dev->descriptor.idVendor != vid) continue; + if (dev->descriptor.idProduct != pid) continue; + h = usb_open(dev); + if (!h) { + printf_verbose("Found device but unable to open"); + continue; + } + #ifdef LIBUSB_HAS_GET_DRIVER_NP + r = usb_get_driver_np(h, 0, buf, sizeof(buf)); + if (r >= 0) { + r = usb_detach_kernel_driver_np(h, 0); + if (r < 0) { + usb_close(h); + printf_verbose("Device is in use by \"%s\" driver", buf); + continue; + } + } + #endif + // Mac OS-X - removing this call to usb_claim_interface() might allow + // this to work, even though it is a clear misuse of the libusb API. + // normally Apple's IOKit should be used on Mac OS-X + r = usb_claim_interface(h, 0); + if (r < 0) { + usb_close(h); + printf_verbose("Unable to claim interface, check USB permissions"); + continue; + } + return h; + } + } + return NULL; +} + +static usb_dev_handle *libusb_teensy_handle = NULL; + +int teensy_open(void) +{ + teensy_close(); + libusb_teensy_handle = open_usb_device(0x16C0, 0x0478); + + if (!libusb_teensy_handle) + libusb_teensy_handle = open_usb_device(0x03eb, 0x2067); + + if (!libusb_teensy_handle) return 0; + return 1; +} + +int teensy_write(void *buf, int len, double timeout) +{ + int r; + + if (!libusb_teensy_handle) return 0; + r = usb_control_msg(libusb_teensy_handle, 0x21, 9, 0x0200, 0, (char *)buf, + len, (int)(timeout * 1000.0)); + if (r < 0) return 0; + return 1; +} + +void teensy_close(void) +{ + if (!libusb_teensy_handle) return; + usb_release_interface(libusb_teensy_handle, 0); + usb_close(libusb_teensy_handle); + libusb_teensy_handle = NULL; +} + +int hard_reboot(void) +{ + usb_dev_handle *rebootor; + int r; + + rebootor = open_usb_device(0x16C0, 0x0477); + + if (!rebootor) + rebootor = open_usb_device(0x03eb, 0x2067); + + if (!rebootor) return 0; + r = usb_control_msg(rebootor, 0x21, 9, 0x0200, 0, "reboot", 6, 100); + usb_release_interface(rebootor, 0); + usb_close(rebootor); + if (r < 0) return 0; + return 1; +} + +#endif + + +/****************************************************************/ +/* */ +/* USB Access - Microsoft WIN32 */ +/* */ +/****************************************************************/ + +#if defined(USE_WIN32) + +// http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ms790932.aspx +#include <windows.h> +#include <setupapi.h> +#include <ddk/hidsdi.h> +#include <ddk/hidclass.h> + +HANDLE open_usb_device(int vid, int pid) +{ + GUID guid; + HDEVINFO info; + DWORD index, required_size; + SP_DEVICE_INTERFACE_DATA iface; + SP_DEVICE_INTERFACE_DETAIL_DATA *details; + HIDD_ATTRIBUTES attrib; + HANDLE h; + BOOL ret; + + HidD_GetHidGuid(&guid); + info = SetupDiGetClassDevs(&guid, NULL, NULL, DIGCF_PRESENT | DIGCF_DEVICEINTERFACE); + if (info == INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE) return NULL; + for (index=0; 1 ;index++) { + iface.cbSize = sizeof(SP_DEVICE_INTERFACE_DATA); + ret = SetupDiEnumDeviceInterfaces(info, NULL, &guid, index, &iface); + if (!ret) { + SetupDiDestroyDeviceInfoList(info); + break; + } + SetupDiGetInterfaceDeviceDetail(info, &iface, NULL, 0, &required_size, NULL); + details = (SP_DEVICE_INTERFACE_DETAIL_DATA *)malloc(required_size); + if (details == NULL) continue; + memset(details, 0, required_size); + details->cbSize = sizeof(SP_DEVICE_INTERFACE_DETAIL_DATA); + ret = SetupDiGetDeviceInterfaceDetail(info, &iface, details, + required_size, NULL, NULL); + if (!ret) { + free(details); + continue; + } + h = CreateFile(details->DevicePath, GENERIC_READ|GENERIC_WRITE, + FILE_SHARE_READ|FILE_SHARE_WRITE, NULL, OPEN_EXISTING, + FILE_FLAG_OVERLAPPED, NULL); + free(details); + if (h == INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE) continue; + attrib.Size = sizeof(HIDD_ATTRIBUTES); + ret = HidD_GetAttributes(h, &attrib); + if (!ret) { + CloseHandle(h); + continue; + } + if (attrib.VendorID != vid || attrib.ProductID != pid) { + CloseHandle(h); + continue; + } + SetupDiDestroyDeviceInfoList(info); + return h; + } + return NULL; +} + +int write_usb_device(HANDLE h, void *buf, int len, int timeout) +{ + static HANDLE event = NULL; + unsigned char tmpbuf[1040]; + OVERLAPPED ov; + DWORD n, r; + + if (len > sizeof(tmpbuf) - 1) return 0; + if (event == NULL) { + event = CreateEvent(NULL, TRUE, TRUE, NULL); + if (!event) return 0; + } + ResetEvent(&event); + memset(&ov, 0, sizeof(ov)); + ov.hEvent = event; + tmpbuf[0] = 0; + memcpy(tmpbuf + 1, buf, len); + if (!WriteFile(h, tmpbuf, len + 1, NULL, &ov)) { + if (GetLastError() != ERROR_IO_PENDING) return 0; + r = WaitForSingleObject(event, timeout); + if (r == WAIT_TIMEOUT) { + CancelIo(h); + return 0; + } + if (r != WAIT_OBJECT_0) return 0; + } + if (!GetOverlappedResult(h, &ov, &n, FALSE)) return 0; + return 1; +} + +static HANDLE win32_teensy_handle = NULL; + +int teensy_open(void) +{ + teensy_close(); + win32_teensy_handle = open_usb_device(0x16C0, 0x0478); + + if (!win32_teensy_handle) + win32_teensy_handle = open_usb_device(0x03eb, 0x2067); + + if (!win32_teensy_handle) return 0; + return 1; +} + +int teensy_write(void *buf, int len, double timeout) +{ + int r; + if (!win32_teensy_handle) return 0; + r = write_usb_device(win32_teensy_handle, buf, len, (int)(timeout * 1000.0)); + return r; +} + +void teensy_close(void) +{ + if (!win32_teensy_handle) return; + CloseHandle(win32_teensy_handle); + win32_teensy_handle = NULL; +} + +int hard_reboot(void) +{ + HANDLE rebootor; + int r; + + rebootor = open_usb_device(0x16C0, 0x0477); + + if (!rebootor) + rebootor = open_usb_device(0x03eb, 0x2067); + + if (!rebootor) return 0; + r = write_usb_device(rebootor, "reboot", 6, 100); + CloseHandle(rebootor); + return r; +} + +#endif + + + +/****************************************************************/ +/* */ +/* USB Access - Apple's IOKit, Mac OS-X */ +/* */ +/****************************************************************/ + +#if defined(USE_APPLE_IOKIT) + +// http://developer.apple.com/technotes/tn2007/tn2187.html +#include <IOKit/IOKitLib.h> +#include <IOKit/hid/IOHIDLib.h> +#include <IOKit/hid/IOHIDDevice.h> + +struct usb_list_struct { + IOHIDDeviceRef ref; + int pid; + int vid; + struct usb_list_struct *next; +}; + +static struct usb_list_struct *usb_list=NULL; +static IOHIDManagerRef hid_manager=NULL; + +void attach_callback(void *context, IOReturn r, void *hid_mgr, IOHIDDeviceRef dev) +{ + CFTypeRef type; + struct usb_list_struct *n, *p; + int32_t pid, vid; + + if (!dev) return; + type = IOHIDDeviceGetProperty(dev, CFSTR(kIOHIDVendorIDKey)); + if (!type || CFGetTypeID(type) != CFNumberGetTypeID()) return; + if (!CFNumberGetValue((CFNumberRef)type, kCFNumberSInt32Type, &vid)) return; + type = IOHIDDeviceGetProperty(dev, CFSTR(kIOHIDProductIDKey)); + if (!type || CFGetTypeID(type) != CFNumberGetTypeID()) return; + if (!CFNumberGetValue((CFNumberRef)type, kCFNumberSInt32Type, &pid)) return; + n = (struct usb_list_struct *)malloc(sizeof(struct usb_list_struct)); + if (!n) return; + //printf("attach callback: vid=%04X, pid=%04X\n", vid, pid); + n->ref = dev; + n->vid = vid; + n->pid = pid; + n->next = NULL; + if (usb_list == NULL) { + usb_list = n; + } else { + for (p = usb_list; p->next; p = p->next) ; + p->next = n; + } +} + +void detach_callback(void *context, IOReturn r, void *hid_mgr, IOHIDDeviceRef dev) +{ + struct usb_list_struct *p, *tmp, *prev=NULL; + + p = usb_list; + while (p) { + if (p->ref == dev) { + if (prev) { + prev->next = p->next; + } else { + usb_list = p->next; + } + tmp = p; + p = p->next; + free(tmp); + } else { + prev = p; + p = p->next; + } + } +} + +void init_hid_manager(void) +{ + CFMutableDictionaryRef dict; + IOReturn ret; + + if (hid_manager) return; + hid_manager = IOHIDManagerCreate(kCFAllocatorDefault, kIOHIDOptionsTypeNone); + if (hid_manager == NULL || CFGetTypeID(hid_manager) != IOHIDManagerGetTypeID()) { + if (hid_manager) CFRelease(hid_manager); + printf_verbose("no HID Manager - maybe this is a pre-Leopard (10.5) system?\n"); + return; + } + dict = CFDictionaryCreateMutable(kCFAllocatorDefault, 0, + &kCFTypeDictionaryKeyCallBacks, &kCFTypeDictionaryValueCallBacks); + if (!dict) return; + IOHIDManagerSetDeviceMatching(hid_manager, dict); + CFRelease(dict); + IOHIDManagerScheduleWithRunLoop(hid_manager, CFRunLoopGetCurrent(), kCFRunLoopDefaultMode); + IOHIDManagerRegisterDeviceMatchingCallback(hid_manager, attach_callback, NULL); + IOHIDManagerRegisterDeviceRemovalCallback(hid_manager, detach_callback, NULL); + ret = IOHIDManagerOpen(hid_manager, kIOHIDOptionsTypeNone); + if (ret != kIOReturnSuccess) { + IOHIDManagerUnscheduleFromRunLoop(hid_manager, + CFRunLoopGetCurrent(), kCFRunLoopDefaultMode); + CFRelease(hid_manager); + printf_verbose("Error opening HID Manager"); + } +} + +static void do_run_loop(void) +{ + while (CFRunLoopRunInMode(kCFRunLoopDefaultMode, 0, true) == kCFRunLoopRunHandledSource) ; +} + +IOHIDDeviceRef open_usb_device(int vid, int pid) +{ + struct usb_list_struct *p; + IOReturn ret; + + init_hid_manager(); + do_run_loop(); + for (p = usb_list; p; p = p->next) { + if (p->vid == vid && p->pid == pid) { + ret = IOHIDDeviceOpen(p->ref, kIOHIDOptionsTypeNone); + if (ret == kIOReturnSuccess) return p->ref; + } + } + return NULL; +} + +void close_usb_device(IOHIDDeviceRef dev) +{ + struct usb_list_struct *p; + + do_run_loop(); + for (p = usb_list; p; p = p->next) { + if (p->ref == dev) { + IOHIDDeviceClose(dev, kIOHIDOptionsTypeNone); + return; + } + } +} + +static IOHIDDeviceRef iokit_teensy_reference = NULL; + +int teensy_open(void) +{ + teensy_close(); + iokit_teensy_reference = open_usb_device(0x16C0, 0x0478); + + if (!iokit_teensy_reference) + iokit_teensy_reference = open_usb_device(0x03eb, 0x2067); + + if (!iokit_teensy_reference) return 0; + return 1; +} + +int teensy_write(void *buf, int len, double timeout) +{ + IOReturn ret; + + // timeouts do not work on OS-X + // IOHIDDeviceSetReportWithCallback is not implemented + // even though Apple documents it with a code example! + // submitted to Apple on 22-sep-2009, problem ID 7245050 + if (!iokit_teensy_reference) return 0; + ret = IOHIDDeviceSetReport(iokit_teensy_reference, + kIOHIDReportTypeOutput, 0, buf, len); + if (ret == kIOReturnSuccess) return 1; + return 0; +} + +void teensy_close(void) +{ + if (!iokit_teensy_reference) return; + close_usb_device(iokit_teensy_reference); + iokit_teensy_reference = NULL; +} + +int hard_reboot(void) +{ + IOHIDDeviceRef rebootor; + IOReturn ret; + + rebootor = open_usb_device(0x16C0, 0x0477); + + if (!rebootor) + rebootor = open_usb_device(0x03eb, 0x2067); + + if (!rebootor) return 0; + ret = IOHIDDeviceSetReport(rebootor, + kIOHIDReportTypeOutput, 0, (uint8_t *)("reboot"), 6); + close_usb_device(rebootor); + if (ret == kIOReturnSuccess) return 1; + return 0; +} + +#endif + + + +/****************************************************************/ +/* */ +/* USB Access - BSD's UHID driver */ +/* */ +/****************************************************************/ + +#if defined(USE_UHID) + +// Thanks to Todd T Fries for help getting this working on OpenBSD +// and to Chris Kuethe for the initial patch to use UHID. + +#include <sys/ioctl.h> +#include <fcntl.h> +#include <dirent.h> +#include <dev/usb/usb.h> +#ifndef USB_GET_DEVICEINFO +#include <dev/usb/usb_ioctl.h> +#endif + +#ifndef USB_GET_DEVICEINFO +# define USB_GET_DEVICEINFO 0 +# error The USB_GET_DEVICEINFO ioctl() value is not defined for your system. +#endif + +int open_usb_device(int vid, int pid) +{ + int r, fd; + DIR *dir; + struct dirent *d; + struct usb_device_info info; + char buf[256]; + + dir = opendir("/dev"); + if (!dir) return -1; + while ((d = readdir(dir)) != NULL) { + if (strncmp(d->d_name, "uhid", 4) != 0) continue; + snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "/dev/%s", d->d_name); + fd = open(buf, O_RDWR); + if (fd < 0) continue; + r = ioctl(fd, USB_GET_DEVICEINFO, &info); + if (r < 0) { + // NetBSD: added in 2004 + // OpenBSD: added November 23, 2009 + // FreeBSD: missing (FreeBSD 8.0) - USE_LIBUSB works! + die("Error: your uhid driver does not support" + " USB_GET_DEVICEINFO, please upgrade!\n"); + close(fd); + closedir(dir); + exit(1); + } + //printf("%s: v=%d, p=%d\n", buf, info.udi_vendorNo, info.udi_productNo); + if (info.udi_vendorNo == vid && info.udi_productNo == pid) { + closedir(dir); + return fd; + } + close(fd); + } + closedir(dir); + return -1; +} + +static int uhid_teensy_fd = -1; + +int teensy_open(void) +{ + teensy_close(); + uhid_teensy_fd = open_usb_device(0x16C0, 0x0478); + + if (uhid_teensy_fd < 0) + uhid_teensy_fd = open_usb_device(0x03eb, 0x2067); + + if (uhid_teensy_fd < 0) return 0; + return 1; +} + +int teensy_write(void *buf, int len, double timeout) +{ + int r; + + // TODO: implement timeout... how?? + r = write(uhid_teensy_fd, buf, len); + if (r == len) return 1; + return 0; +} + +void teensy_close(void) +{ + if (uhid_teensy_fd >= 0) { + close(uhid_teensy_fd); + uhid_teensy_fd = -1; + } +} + +int hard_reboot(void) +{ + int r, rebootor_fd; + + rebootor_fd = open_usb_device(0x16C0, 0x0477); + + if (rebootor_fd < 0) + rebootor_fd = open_usb_device(0x03eb, 0x2067); + + if (rebootor_fd < 0) return 0; + r = write(rebootor_fd, "reboot", 6); + delay(0.1); + close(rebootor_fd); + if (r == 6) return 1; + return 0; +} + +#endif + + + +/****************************************************************/ +/* */ +/* Read Intel Hex File */ +/* */ +/****************************************************************/ + +// the maximum flash image size we can support +// chips with larger memory may be used, but only this +// much intel-hex data can be loaded into memory! +#define MAX_MEMORY_SIZE 0x10000 + +static unsigned char firmware_image[MAX_MEMORY_SIZE]; +static unsigned char firmware_mask[MAX_MEMORY_SIZE]; +static int end_record_seen=0; +static int byte_count; +static unsigned int extended_addr = 0; +static int parse_hex_line(char *line); + +int read_intel_hex(const char *filename) +{ + FILE *fp; + int i, lineno=0; + char buf[1024]; + + byte_count = 0; + end_record_seen = 0; + for (i=0; i<MAX_MEMORY_SIZE; i++) { + firmware_image[i] = 0xFF; + firmware_mask[i] = 0; + } + extended_addr = 0; + + fp = fopen(filename, "r"); + if (fp == NULL) { + //printf("Unable to read file %s\n", filename); + return -1; + } + while (!feof(fp)) { + *buf = '\0'; + if (!fgets(buf, sizeof(buf), fp)) break; + lineno++; + if (*buf) { + if (parse_hex_line(buf) == 0) { + //printf("Warning, parse error line %d\n", lineno); + fclose(fp); + return -2; + } + } + if (end_record_seen) break; + if (feof(stdin)) break; + } + fclose(fp); + return byte_count; +} + + +/* from ihex.c, at http://www.pjrc.com/tech/8051/pm2_docs/intel-hex.html */ + +/* parses a line of intel hex code, stores the data in bytes[] */ +/* and the beginning address in addr, and returns a 1 if the */ +/* line was valid, or a 0 if an error occurred. The variable */ +/* num gets the number of bytes that were stored into bytes[] */ + + +int +parse_hex_line(char *line) +{ + int addr, code, num; + int sum, len, cksum, i; + char *ptr; + + num = 0; + if (line[0] != ':') return 0; + if (strlen(line) < 11) return 0; + ptr = line+1; + if (!sscanf(ptr, "%02x", &len)) return 0; + ptr += 2; + if ((int)strlen(line) < (11 + (len * 2)) ) return 0; + if (!sscanf(ptr, "%04x", &addr)) return 0; + ptr += 4; + /* printf("Line: length=%d Addr=%d\n", len, addr); */ + if (!sscanf(ptr, "%02x", &code)) return 0; + if (addr + extended_addr + len >= MAX_MEMORY_SIZE) return 0; + ptr += 2; + sum = (len & 255) + ((addr >> 8) & 255) + (addr & 255) + (code & 255); + if (code != 0) { + if (code == 1) { + end_record_seen = 1; + return 1; + } + if (code == 2 && len == 2) { + if (!sscanf(ptr, "%04x", &i)) return 1; + ptr += 4; + sum += ((i >> 8) & 255) + (i & 255); + if (!sscanf(ptr, "%02x", &cksum)) return 1; + if (((sum & 255) + (cksum & 255)) & 255) return 1; + extended_addr = i << 4; + //printf("ext addr = %05X\n", extended_addr); + } + if (code == 4 && len == 2) { + if (!sscanf(ptr, "%04x", &i)) return 1; + ptr += 4; + sum += ((i >> 8) & 255) + (i & 255); + if (!sscanf(ptr, "%02x", &cksum)) return 1; + if (((sum & 255) + (cksum & 255)) & 255) return 1; + extended_addr = i << 16; + //printf("ext addr = %08X\n", extended_addr); + } + return 1; // non-data line + } + byte_count += len; + while (num != len) { + if (sscanf(ptr, "%02x", &i) != 1) return 0; + i &= 255; + firmware_image[addr + extended_addr + num] = i; + firmware_mask[addr + extended_addr + num] = 1; + ptr += 2; + sum += i; + (num)++; + if (num >= 256) return 0; + } + if (!sscanf(ptr, "%02x", &cksum)) return 0; + if (((sum & 255) + (cksum & 255)) & 255) return 0; /* checksum error */ + return 1; +} + +int ihex_bytes_within_range(int begin, int end) +{ + int i; + + if (begin < 0 || begin >= MAX_MEMORY_SIZE || + end < 0 || end >= MAX_MEMORY_SIZE) { + return 0; + } + for (i=begin; i<=end; i++) { + if (firmware_mask[i]) return 1; + } + return 0; +} + +void ihex_get_data(int addr, int len, unsigned char *bytes) +{ + int i; + + if (addr < 0 || len < 0 || addr + len >= MAX_MEMORY_SIZE) { + for (i=0; i<len; i++) { + bytes[i] = 255; + } + return; + } + for (i=0; i<len; i++) { + if (firmware_mask[addr]) { + bytes[i] = firmware_image[addr]; + } else { + bytes[i] = 255; + } + addr++; + } +} + +/****************************************************************/ +/* */ +/* Misc Functions */ +/* */ +/****************************************************************/ + +int printf_verbose(const char *format, ...) +{ + va_list ap; + int r = 0; + + va_start(ap, format); + if (verbose) { + r = vprintf(format, ap); + fflush(stdout); + } + va_end(ap); + + return r; +} + +void delay(double seconds) +{ + #ifdef USE_WIN32 + sleep(seconds * 1000.0); + #else + usleep(seconds * 1000000.0); + #endif +} + +void die(const char *str, ...) +{ + va_list ap; + + va_start(ap, str); + vfprintf(stderr, str, ap); + fprintf(stderr, "\n"); + va_end(ap); + + exit(1); +} + +#if defined USE_WIN32 +#define strcasecmp stricmp +#endif + +void parse_options(int argc, char **argv) +{ + int i; + const char *arg; + + for (i=1; i<argc; i++) { + arg = argv[i]; + + if (*arg == '-') { + if (strcmp(arg, "-w") == 0) { + wait_for_device_to_appear = 1; + } else if (strcmp(arg, "-r") == 0) { + hard_reboot_device = 1; + } else if (strcmp(arg, "-n") == 0) { + reboot_after_programming = 0; + } else if (strcmp(arg, "-v") == 0) { + verbose = 1; + } else if (strncmp(arg, "-mmcu=", 6) == 0) { + arg += 6; + + if (strncmp(arg, "at90usb", 7) == 0) { + arg += 7; + } else if (strncmp(arg, "atmega", 6) == 0) { + arg += 6; + } else { + die("Unknown MCU type\n"); + } + + if (strncmp(arg, "128", 3) == 0) { + code_size = 128 * 1024; + block_size = 256; + } else if (strncmp(arg, "64", 2) == 0) { + code_size = 64 * 1024; + block_size = 256; + } else if (strncmp(arg, "32", 2) == 0) { + code_size = 32 * 1024; + block_size = 128; + } else if (strncmp(arg, "16", 2) == 0) { + code_size = 16 * 1024; + block_size = 128; + } else if (strncmp(arg, "8", 1) == 0) { + code_size = 8 * 1024; + block_size = 128; + } else { + die("Unknown MCU type\n"); + } + } + } else { + filename = argv[i]; + } + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp_Python/hid_bootloader_loader.py b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp_Python/hid_bootloader_loader.py new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cb824f5822 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/HostLoaderApp_Python/hid_bootloader_loader.py @@ -0,0 +1,120 @@ +""" + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +""" + +""" + Front-end programmer for the LUFA HID class bootloader. + + Usage: + python hid_bootloader_loader.py <Device> <Input>.hex + + Example: + python hid_bootloader_loader.py at90usb1287 Mouse.hex + + Requires the pywinusb (https://pypi.python.org/pypi/pywinusb/) and + IntelHex (https://pypi.python.org/pypi/IntelHex/) libraries. +""" + +import sys +from pywinusb import hid +from intelhex import IntelHex + + +# Device information table +device_info_map = dict() +device_info_map['at90usb1287'] = {'page_size': 256, 'flash_kb': 128} +device_info_map['at90usb1286'] = {'page_size': 256, 'flash_kb': 128} +device_info_map['at90usb647'] = {'page_size': 256, 'flash_kb': 64} +device_info_map['at90usb646'] = {'page_size': 256, 'flash_kb': 64} +device_info_map['atmega32u4'] = {'page_size': 128, 'flash_kb': 32} +device_info_map['atmega32u2'] = {'page_size': 128, 'flash_kb': 32} +device_info_map['atmega16u4'] = {'page_size': 128, 'flash_kb': 16} +device_info_map['atmega16u2'] = {'page_size': 128, 'flash_kb': 16} +device_info_map['at90usb162'] = {'page_size': 128, 'flash_kb': 16} +device_info_map['atmega8u2'] = {'page_size': 128, 'flash_kb': 8} +device_info_map['at90usb82'] = {'page_size': 128, 'flash_kb': 8} + + +def get_hid_device_handle(): + hid_device_filter = hid.HidDeviceFilter(vendor_id=0x03EB, + product_id=0x2067) + + valid_hid_devices = hid_device_filter.get_devices() + + if len(valid_hid_devices) is 0: + return None + else: + return valid_hid_devices[0] + + +def send_page_data(hid_device, address, data): + # Bootloader page data should be the HID Report ID (always zero) followed + # by the starting address to program, then one device's flash page worth + # of data + output_report_data = [0] + output_report_data.extend([address & 0xFF, address >> 8]) + output_report_data.extend(data) + + hid_device.send_output_report(output_report_data) + + +def program_device(hex_data, device_info): + hid_device = get_hid_device_handle() + + if hid_device is None: + print("No valid HID device found.") + sys.exit(1) + + try: + hid_device.open() + print("Connected to bootloader.") + + # Program in all data from the loaded HEX file, in a number of device + # page sized chunks + for addr in range(0, hex_data.maxaddr(), device_info['page_size']): + # Compute the address range of the current page in the device + current_page_range = range(addr, addr+device_info['page_size']) + + # Extract the data from the hex file at the specified start page + # address and convert it to a regular list of bytes + page_data = [hex_data[i] for i in current_page_range] + + print("Writing address 0x%04X-0x%04X" % (current_page_range[0], current_page_range[-1])) + + # Devices with more than 64KB of flash should shift down the page + # address so that it is 16-bit (page size is guaranteed to be + # >= 256 bytes so no non-zero address bits are discarded) + if device_info['flash_kb'] < 64: + send_page_data(hid_device, addr, page_data) + else: + send_page_data(hid_device, addr >> 8, page_data) + + # Once programming is complete, start the application via a dummy page + # program to the page address 0xFFFF + print("Programming complete, starting application.") + send_page_data(hid_device, 0xFFFF, [0] * device_info['page_size']) + + finally: + hid_device.close() + + +if __name__ == '__main__': + # Load the specified HEX file + try: + hex_data = IntelHex(sys.argv[2]) + except: + print("Could not open the specified HEX file.") + sys.exit(1) + + # Retrieve the device information entry for the specified device + try: + device_info = device_info_map[sys.argv[1]] + except: + print("Unknown device name specified.") + sys.exit(1) + + program_device(hex_data, device_info) diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9394b13530 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,123 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="HID Bootloader - 128KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.hid.avr8.128_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_hid_128kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.hid"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x1F000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x1F000"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="HID Bootloader - 64KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.hid.avr8.64_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_hid_64kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.hid"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb647"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0xF000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0xF000"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="HID Bootloader - 32KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.hid.avr8.32_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_hid_32kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.hid"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u4"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x7000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x7000"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="HID Bootloader - 16KB FLASH / 2KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.hid.avr8.16_2" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_hid_16kb_2kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.hid"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega16u2"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x3800"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x3800"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="HID Bootloader - 8KB FLASH / 2KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.hid.avr8.8_2" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_hid_8kb_2kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.hid"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega8u2"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x1800"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x1800"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.bootloaders.hid" caption="HID Bootloader">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ HID Class Bootloader, capable of reprogramming a device via a custom cross-platform command line utility when plugged into a host.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Bootloaders"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value="."/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="BootloaderHID.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="BootloaderHID.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="BootloaderHID.txt"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="directory" value="HostLoaderApp"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="directory" value="HostLoaderApp_Python"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4c3de5ab98 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2398 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - HID Class Bootloader" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ \ + HostLoaderApp/ \ + HostLoaderApp_Python/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM \ + ATTR_NO_INIT + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/makefile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..12cfadb5d4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/HID/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,55 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = BootloaderHID +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -DBOOT_START_ADDR=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET) -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = -Wl,--section-start=.text=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET) + +# Flash size and bootloader section sizes of the target, in KB. These must +# match the target's total FLASH size and the bootloader size set in the +# device's fuses. +FLASH_SIZE_KB := 128 +BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB := 8 + +# Bootloader address calculation formulas +# Do not modify these macros, but rather modify the dependent values above. +CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX = $(shell printf "0x%X" $$(( $(1) )) ) +BOOT_START_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) - $(BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB)) * 1024 ) +BOOT_SEC_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) * 1024) - ($(strip $(1))) ) + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderAPI.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderAPI.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..491c506d0f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderAPI.c @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Bootloader user application API functions. + */ + +#include "BootloaderAPI.h" + +void BootloaderAPI_ErasePage(const uint32_t Address) +{ + boot_page_erase_safe(Address); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + boot_rww_enable(); +} + +void BootloaderAPI_WritePage(const uint32_t Address) +{ + boot_page_write_safe(Address); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + boot_rww_enable(); +} + +void BootloaderAPI_FillWord(const uint32_t Address, const uint16_t Word) +{ + boot_page_fill_safe(Address, Word); +} + +uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature(const uint16_t Address) +{ + return boot_signature_byte_get(Address); +} + +uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse(const uint16_t Address) +{ + return boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(Address); +} + +uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadLock(void) +{ + return boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_LOCK_BITS); +} + +void BootloaderAPI_WriteLock(const uint8_t LockBits) +{ + boot_lock_bits_set_safe(LockBits); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderAPI.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderAPI.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4889b4c0db --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderAPI.h @@ -0,0 +1,63 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for BootloaderAPI.c. + */ + +#ifndef _BOOTLOADER_API_H_ +#define _BOOTLOADER_API_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/boot.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + + /* Macros: */ + #if AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE > 0 + #define AUX_BOOT_SECTION __attribute__((section(".boot_aux"))) + #else + #define AUX_BOOT_SECTION + #endif + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void BootloaderAPI_ErasePage(const uint32_t Address); + void BootloaderAPI_WritePage(const uint32_t Address); + void BootloaderAPI_FillWord(const uint32_t Address, const uint16_t Word); + uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature(const uint16_t Address); + uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse(const uint16_t Address); + uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadLock(void); + void BootloaderAPI_WriteLock(const uint8_t LockBits); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderAPITable.S b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderAPITable.S new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..30165700d7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderAPITable.S @@ -0,0 +1,102 @@ +/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+*/
+
+/*
+ Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+ Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this
+ software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted
+ without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in
+ all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+ permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+ documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+ advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+ software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+ The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this
+ software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+ and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
+ special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+ whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+ in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+ arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+ this software.
+*/
+
+#if AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE > 0
+#warning Using a AUX bootloader section in addition to the defined bootloader space (see documentation).
+
+; Trampoline to jump over the AUX bootloader section to the start of the bootloader,
+; on devices where an AUX bootloader section is used.
+.section .boot_aux_trampoline, "ax"
+.global Boot_AUX_Trampoline
+Boot_AUX_Trampoline:
+ jmp BOOT_START_ADDR
+#endif
+
+; Trampolines to actual API implementations if the target address is outside the
+; range of a rjmp instruction (can happen with large bootloader sections)
+.section .apitable_trampolines, "ax"
+.global BootloaderAPI_Trampolines
+BootloaderAPI_Trampolines:
+
+ BootloaderAPI_ErasePage_Trampoline:
+ jmp BootloaderAPI_ErasePage
+ BootloaderAPI_WritePage_Trampoline:
+ jmp BootloaderAPI_WritePage
+ BootloaderAPI_FillWord_Trampoline:
+ jmp BootloaderAPI_FillWord
+ BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature_Trampoline:
+ jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature
+ BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse_Trampoline:
+ jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse
+ BootloaderAPI_ReadLock_Trampoline:
+ jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadLock
+ BootloaderAPI_WriteLock_Trampoline:
+ jmp BootloaderAPI_WriteLock
+ BootloaderAPI_UNUSED1:
+ ret
+ BootloaderAPI_UNUSED2:
+ ret
+ BootloaderAPI_UNUSED3:
+ ret
+ BootloaderAPI_UNUSED4:
+ ret
+ BootloaderAPI_UNUSED5:
+ ret
+
+
+
+; API function jump table
+.section .apitable_jumptable, "ax"
+.global BootloaderAPI_JumpTable
+BootloaderAPI_JumpTable:
+
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_ErasePage_Trampoline
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_WritePage_Trampoline
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_FillWord_Trampoline
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature_Trampoline
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse_Trampoline
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadLock_Trampoline
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_WriteLock_Trampoline
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED1 ; UNUSED ENTRY 1
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED2 ; UNUSED ENTRY 2
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED3 ; UNUSED ENTRY 3
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED4 ; UNUSED ENTRY 4
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED5 ; UNUSED ENTRY 5
+
+
+
+; Bootloader table signatures and information
+.section .apitable_signatures, "ax"
+.global BootloaderAPI_Signatures
+BootloaderAPI_Signatures:
+
+ .long BOOT_START_ADDR ; Start address of the bootloader
+ .word 0xDF30 ; Signature for the MS class bootloader, V1
+ .word 0xDCFB ; Signature for a LUFA class bootloader
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderMassStorage.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderMassStorage.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6c9697b660 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderMassStorage.c @@ -0,0 +1,263 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the Mass Storage class bootloader. This file contains the complete bootloader logic. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADER_MASSSTORAGE_C +#include "BootloaderMassStorage.h" + +/** LUFA Mass Storage Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all Mass Storage Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t Disk_MS_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR, + .Size = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR, + .Size = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .TotalLUNs = 1, + }, + }; + +/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader should be running, or should exit and allow the application code to run + * via a soft reset. When cleared, the bootloader will abort, the USB interface will shut down and the application + * started via a forced watchdog reset. + */ +bool RunBootloader = true; + +/** Magic lock for forced application start. If the HWBE fuse is programmed and BOOTRST is unprogrammed, the bootloader + * will start if the /HWB line of the AVR is held low and the system is reset. However, if the /HWB line is still held + * low when the application attempts to start via a watchdog reset, the bootloader will re-start. If set to the value + * \ref MAGIC_BOOT_KEY the special init function \ref Application_Jump_Check() will force the application to start. + */ +uint16_t MagicBootKey ATTR_NO_INIT; + +/** Indicates if the bootloader is allowed to exit immediately if \ref RunBootloader is \c false. During shutdown all + * pending commands must be processed before jumping to the user-application, thus this tracks the main program loop + * iterations since a SCSI command from the host was received. + */ +static uint8_t TicksSinceLastCommand = 0; + + +/** Special startup routine to check if the bootloader was started via a watchdog reset, and if the magic application + * start key has been loaded into \ref MagicBootKey. If the bootloader started via the watchdog and the key is valid, + * this will force the user application to start via a software jump. + */ +void Application_Jump_Check(void) +{ + bool JumpToApplication = false; + + #if (BOARD == BOARD_LEONARDO) + /* Enable pull-up on the IO13 pin so we can use it to select the mode */ + PORTC |= (1 << 7); + Delay_MS(10); + + /* If IO13 is not jumpered to ground, start the user application instead */ + JumpToApplication = ((PINC & (1 << 7)) != 0); + + /* Disable pull-up after the check has completed */ + PORTC &= ~(1 << 7); + #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + /* Disable JTAG debugging */ + JTAG_DISABLE(); + + /* Enable pull-up on the JTAG TCK pin so we can use it to select the mode */ + PORTF |= (1 << 4); + Delay_MS(10); + + /* If the TCK pin is not jumpered to ground, start the user application instead */ + JumpToApplication = ((PINF & (1 << 4)) != 0); + + /* Re-enable JTAG debugging */ + JTAG_ENABLE(); + #else + /* Check if the device's BOOTRST fuse is set */ + if (boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_HIGH_FUSE_BITS) & FUSE_BOOTRST) + { + /* If the reset source was not an external reset or the key is correct, clear it and jump to the application */ + if (!(MCUSR & (1 << EXTRF)) || (MagicBootKey == MAGIC_BOOT_KEY)) + JumpToApplication = true; + + /* Clear reset source */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << EXTRF); + } + else + { + /* If the reset source was the bootloader and the key is correct, clear it and jump to the application; + * this can happen in the HWBE fuse is set, and the HBE pin is low during the watchdog reset */ + if ((MCUSR & (1 << WDRF)) && (MagicBootKey == MAGIC_BOOT_KEY)) + JumpToApplication = true; + + /* Clear reset source */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + } + #endif + + /* Don't run the user application if the reset vector is blank (no app loaded) */ + bool ApplicationValid = (pgm_read_word_near(0) != 0xFFFF); + + /* If a request has been made to jump to the user application, honor it */ + if (JumpToApplication && ApplicationValid) + { + /* Turn off the watchdog */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Clear the boot key and jump to the user application */ + MagicBootKey = 0; + + // cppcheck-suppress constStatement + ((void (*)(void))0x0000)(); + } +} + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + while (RunBootloader || TicksSinceLastCommand++ < 0xFF) + { + MS_Device_USBTask(&Disk_MS_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } + + /* Disconnect from the host - USB interface will be reset later along with the AVR */ + USB_Detach(); + + /* Unlock the forced application start mode of the bootloader if it is restarted */ + MagicBootKey = MAGIC_BOOT_KEY; + + /* Enable the watchdog and force a timeout to reset the AVR */ + wdt_enable(WDTO_250MS); + + for (;;); +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +static void SetupHardware(void) +{ + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); + + /* Relocate the interrupt vector table to the bootloader section */ + MCUCR = (1 << IVCE); + MCUCR = (1 << IVSEL); + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Bootloader active LED toggle timer initialization */ + TIMSK1 = (1 << TOIE1); + TCCR1B = ((1 << CS11) | (1 << CS10)); +} + +/** ISR to periodically toggle the LEDs on the board to indicate that the bootloader is active. */ +ISR(TIMER1_OVF_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB enumerating */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via + * the status LEDs and stops the Mass Storage management task. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB not ready */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + /* Setup Mass Storage Data Endpoints */ + ConfigSuccess &= MS_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Disk_MS_Interface); + + /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + MS_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Disk_MS_Interface); +} + +/** Mass Storage class driver callback function the reception of SCSI commands from the host, which must be processed. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface configuration structure being referenced + */ +bool CALLBACK_MS_Device_SCSICommandReceived(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + bool CommandSuccess; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + CommandSuccess = SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(MSInterfaceInfo); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + + /* Signal that a command was processed, must not exit bootloader yet */ + TicksSinceLastCommand = 0; + + return CommandSuccess; +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderMassStorage.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderMassStorage.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c9ddee4d7f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderMassStorage.h @@ -0,0 +1,99 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for BootloaderMassStorage.c. + */ + +#ifndef _BOOTLOADER_MASS_STORAGE_H_ +#define _BOOTLOADER_MASS_STORAGE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include "Lib/SCSI.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__OPTIMIZE_SIZE__) + #error This bootloader requires that it be optimized for size, not speed, to fit into the target device. Change optimization settings and try again. + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 + + /** Magic bootloader key to unlock forced application start mode. */ + #define MAGIC_BOOT_KEY 0xDC42 + + /* Global Variables: */ + extern bool RunBootloader; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + int main(void) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + + void Application_Jump_Check(void) ATTR_INIT_SECTION(3); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + + bool CALLBACK_MS_Device_SCSICommandReceived(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADER_MASSSTORAGE_C) + static void SetupHardware(void) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderMassStorage.txt b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderMassStorage.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0fea9d9fb5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/BootloaderMassStorage.txt @@ -0,0 +1,240 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Mass Storage Class USB AVR Bootloader + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) - <i>See \ref SSec_Aux_Space</i> + * \li ATMEGA32U2 - <i>See \ref SSec_Aux_Space</i> + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Mass Storage Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Bulk-Only Transport</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Mass Storage Standard \n + * USB Bulk-Only Transport Standard \n + * SCSI Primary Commands Specification \n + * SCSI Block Commands Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * This bootloader enumerates to the host as a Mass Storage device, capable of reading and writing a new binary + * firmware image file, to load firmware onto the AVR. + * + * Out of the box this bootloader builds for the AT90USB1287 with an 8KB bootloader section size, and will fit + * into 6KB of bootloader space. If you wish to alter this size and/or change the AVR model, you will need to + * edit the MCU, FLASH_SIZE_KB and BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB values in the accompanying makefile. + * + * When the bootloader is running, the board's LED(s) will flash at regular intervals to distinguish the + * bootloader from the normal user application. + * + * \warning <b>THIS BOOTLOADER IS NOT SECURE.</b> Malicious entities can recover written data, even if the device + * lockbits are set. + * + * \section Sec_Running Running the Bootloader + * + * On the USB AVR8 devices, setting the \c HWBE device fuse will cause the bootloader to run if the \c HWB pin of + * the AVR is grounded when the device is reset. + * + * The are two behaviours of this bootloader, depending on the device's fuses: + * + * <b>If the device's BOOTRST fuse is set</b>, the bootloader will run any time the system is reset from + * the external reset pin, unless no valid user application has been loaded. To initiate the bootloader, the + * device's external reset pin should be grounded momentarily. + * + * <b>If the device's BOOTRST fuse is not set</b>, the bootloader will run only if initiated via a software + * jump, or if the \c HWB pin was low during the last device reset (if the \c HWBE fuse is set). + * + * For board specific exceptions to the above, see below. + * + * \subsection SSec_XPLAIN Atmel Xplain Board + * Ground the USB AVR JTAG's \c TCK pin to ground when powering on the board to start the bootloader. This assumes the + * \c HWBE fuse is cleared and the \c BOOTRST fuse is set as the HWBE pin is not user accessible on this board. + * + * \subsection SSec_Leonardo Arduino Leonardo Board + * Ground \c IO13 when powering the board to start the bootloader. This assumes the \c HWBE fuse is cleared and the + * \c BOOTRST fuse is set as the HWBE pin is not user accessible on this board. + * + * \section Sec_Installation Driver Installation + * + * This bootloader uses the Mass Storage drivers inbuilt into all modern operating systems, thus no additional + * drivers need to be supplied for correct operation. + * + * \section Sec_HostApp Host Controller Application + * + * This bootloader is compatible with all operating systems that support the FAT12 file system format. To reprogram the + * device, overwrite a file stored on the virtual FAT filesystem with a new binary (BIN format) image. Remember to safely + * remove your device from the host using the host OS's ejection APIs, to ensure all data is correctly flushed to the + * bootloader's virtual filesystem and not cached in the OS's file system driver. + * + * The current device firmware can be read from the device by reading a file from the virtual FAT filesystem. Two files will + * be present: + * - <b>FLASH.BIN</b>, representing the AVR's internal flash memory + * - <b>EEPROM.BIN</b>, representing the AVR's internal EEPROM memory + * + * To convert an existing Intel HEX (.HEX) program file to a binary (.BIN) file suitable for this bootloader, run: + * \code + * avr-objcopy -O binary -R .eeprom -R .fuse -R .lock -R .signature input.hex output.bin + * \endcode + * From a terminal, replacing <tt>input.hex</tt> and <tt>output.bin</tt> with the respective input and output filenames. + * AVR EEPROM data files in Intel HEX format (.EEP) uses a similar technique: + * \code + * avr-objcopy -O binary input.eep output.bin + * \endcode + * + * \warning This bootloader is currently <b>incompatible with the Apple MacOS X OS Finder GUI</b>, due to the + * large amount of meta files this OS attempts to write to the disk along with the new binaries. On + * this platform, firmwares must be copied to the disk via the Terminal application only to prevent + * firmware corruption. + * + * \section Sec_API User Application API + * + * Several user application functions for FLASH and other special memory area manipulations are exposed by the bootloader, + * allowing the user application to call into the bootloader at runtime to read and write FLASH data. + * + * By default, the bootloader API jump table is located 32 bytes from the end of the device's FLASH memory, and follows the + * following layout: + * + * \code + * #define BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE 32 + * #define BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START ((FLASHEND + 1UL) - BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE) + * #define BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(Index) (void*)((BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (Index * 2)) / 2) + * + * void (*BootloaderAPI_ErasePage)(uint32_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(0); + * void (*BootloaderAPI_WritePage)(uint32_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(1); + * void (*BootloaderAPI_FillWord)(uint32_t Address, uint16_t Word) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(2); + * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature)(uint16_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(3); + * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse)(uint16_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(4); + * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadLock)(void) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(5); + * void (*BootloaderAPI_WriteLock)(uint8_t LockBits) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(6); + * + * #define BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 2)) + * #define BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE 0xDCFB + * + * #define BOOTLOADER_CLASS_SIGNATURE_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 4)) + * #define BOOTLOADER_MASS_STORAGE_SIGNATURE 0xDF30 + * + * #define BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 8)) + * #define BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_LENGTH 4 + * \endcode + * + * From the application the API support of the bootloader can be detected by reading the FLASH memory bytes located at address + * \c BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE_START and comparing them to the value \c BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE. The class of bootloader + * can be determined by reading the FLASH memory bytes located at address \c BOOTLOADER_CLASS_SIGNATURE_START and comparing them + * to the value \c BOOTLOADER_MASS_STORAGE_SIGNATURE. The start address of the bootloader can be retrieved by reading the bytes + * of FLASH memory starting from address \c BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_START. + * + * \subsection SSec_Aux_Space Auxiliary Bootloader Section + * To make the bootloader function on smaller devices (those with a physical bootloader section of smaller than 6KB) a second + * section of memory (called the <i>Auxiliary Bootloader Section</i>) is added before the start of the real bootloader section, + * and is filled with a portion of the bootloader code. This allows smaller devices to run the bootloader, at the cost of an + * additional portion of the device's FLASH (the bootloader section size in KB subtracted from the 6KB total size). A small + * trampoline is inserted at the start of the auxiliary section so that the bootloader will run normally in the case of a blank + * application section. + * + * On devices supporting a 8KB bootloader section size, the AUX section is not created in the final binary. + * + * \subsection SSec_API_MemLayout Device Memory Map + * The following illustration indicates the final memory map of the device when loaded with the bootloader. + * + * \verbatim + * +----------------------------+ 0x0000 + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | User Application | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - BOOT_SECTION_SIZE - BOOT_AUX_SECTION_SIZE + * | Booloader Start Trampoline | + * | (Not User App. Accessible) | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - BOOT_SECTION_SIZE - BOOT_AUX_SECTION_SIZE + 4 + * | | + * | Auxiliary Bootloader | + * | Space for Smaller Devices | + * | (Not User App. Accessible) | + * | | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - BOOT_SECTION_SIZE + * | | + * | Bootloader Application | + * | (Not User App. Accessible) | + * | | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 96 + * | API Table Trampolines | + * | (Not User App. Accessible) | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 32 + * | Bootloader API Table | + * | (User App. Accessible) | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 8 + * | Bootloader ID Constants | + * | (User App. Accessible) | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND + * \endverbatim + * + * \section Sec_KnownIssues Known Issues: + * + * \par In some cases, the application is not fully loaded into the device. + * Write-caching on some operating systems may interfere with the normal + * operation of the bootloader. Write caching should be disabled when using the + * Mass Storage bootloader, or the file system synced via an appropriate command + * (such as the OS's normal disk ejection command) before disconnecting the device. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_APP_START_ON_EJECT</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Define to disable automatic start of the loaded application when the virtual + * Mass Storage disk is ejected on the host.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..92eb364dc9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,47 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure LUFA's + * compile time options, as an alternative to the compile time + * constants supplied through a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + +// #define NO_APP_START_ON_EJECT + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7353178673 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT + #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS + #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 + #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT + #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP + #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e8bdbd4f5c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,157 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2045, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + .ProductStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED, + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .MS_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = MS_CSCP_MassStorageClass, + .SubClass = MS_CSCP_SCSITransparentSubclass, + .Protocol = MS_CSCP_BulkOnlyTransportProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MS_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .MS_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + /* If/Else If chain compiles slightly smaller than a switch case */ + if (DescriptorType == DTYPE_Device) + { + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + } + else if (DescriptorType == DTYPE_Configuration) + { + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..506f41af83 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,88 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "BootloaderAPI.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Mass Storage device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the Mass Storage host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) + + /** Size in bytes of the Mass Storage data endpoints. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE 64 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Mass Storage Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t MS_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t MS_DataInEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t MS_DataOutEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage = 0, /**< Mass storage interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3c14eb9010 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.c @@ -0,0 +1,294 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * SCSI command processing routines, for SCSI commands issued by the host. Mass Storage + * devices use a thin "Bulk-Only Transport" protocol for issuing commands and status information, + * which wrap around standard SCSI device commands for controlling the actual storage medium. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_SCSI_C +#include "SCSI.h" + +/** Structure to hold the SCSI response data to a SCSI INQUIRY command. This gives information about the device's + * features and capabilities. + */ +static const SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t InquiryData = + { + .DeviceType = DEVICE_TYPE_BLOCK, + .PeripheralQualifier = 0, + + .Removable = true, + + .Version = 0, + + .ResponseDataFormat = 2, + .NormACA = false, + .TrmTsk = false, + .AERC = false, + + .AdditionalLength = 0x1F, + + .SoftReset = false, + .CmdQue = false, + .Linked = false, + .Sync = false, + .WideBus16Bit = false, + .WideBus32Bit = false, + .RelAddr = false, + + .VendorID = "LUFA", + .ProductID = "Bootloader", + .RevisionID = {'0','.','0','0'}, + }; + +/** Structure to hold the sense data for the last issued SCSI command, which is returned to the host after a SCSI REQUEST SENSE + * command is issued. This gives information on exactly why the last command failed to complete. + */ +static SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t SenseData = + { + .ResponseCode = 0x70, + .AdditionalLength = 0x0A, + }; + + +/** Main routine to process the SCSI command located in the Command Block Wrapper read from the host. This dispatches + * to the appropriate SCSI command handling routine if the issued command is supported by the device, else it returns + * a command failure due to a ILLEGAL REQUEST. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise + */ +bool SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + bool CommandSuccess = false; + + /* Run the appropriate SCSI command hander function based on the passed command */ + switch (MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[0]) + { + case SCSI_CMD_INQUIRY: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Inquiry(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_REQUEST_SENSE: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_READ_CAPACITY_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_WRITE_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(MSInterfaceInfo, DATA_WRITE); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_READ_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(MSInterfaceInfo, DATA_READ); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_MODE_SENSE_6: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_START_STOP_UNIT: +#if !defined(NO_APP_START_ON_EJECT) + /* If the user ejected the volume, signal bootloader exit at next opportunity. */ + RunBootloader = ((MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[4] & 0x03) != 0x02); +#endif + case SCSI_CMD_SEND_DIAGNOSTIC: + case SCSI_CMD_TEST_UNIT_READY: + case SCSI_CMD_PREVENT_ALLOW_MEDIUM_REMOVAL: + case SCSI_CMD_VERIFY_10: + /* These commands should just succeed, no handling required */ + CommandSuccess = true; + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength = 0; + break; + default: + /* Update the SENSE key to reflect the invalid command */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_COMMAND, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + break; + } + + /* Check if command was successfully processed */ + if (CommandSuccess) + { + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_GOOD, + SCSI_ASENSE_NO_ADDITIONAL_INFORMATION, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return true; + } + + return false; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI INQUIRY command. This command returns information about the device's features + * and capabilities to the host. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Inquiry(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint16_t AllocationLength = SwapEndian_16(*(uint16_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[3]); + uint16_t BytesTransferred = MIN(AllocationLength, sizeof(InquiryData)); + + /* Only the standard INQUIRY data is supported, check if any optional INQUIRY bits set */ + if ((MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[1] & ((1 << 0) | (1 << 1))) || + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[2]) + { + /* Optional but unsupported bits set - update the SENSE key and fail the request */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_FIELD_IN_CDB, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&InquiryData, BytesTransferred, NULL); + + /* Pad out remaining bytes with 0x00 */ + Endpoint_Null_Stream((AllocationLength - BytesTransferred), NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= BytesTransferred; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI REQUEST SENSE command. This command returns information about the last issued command, + * including the error code and additional error information so that the host can determine why a command failed to complete. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint8_t AllocationLength = MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[4]; + uint8_t BytesTransferred = MIN(AllocationLength, sizeof(SenseData)); + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&SenseData, BytesTransferred, NULL); + Endpoint_Null_Stream((AllocationLength - BytesTransferred), NULL); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= BytesTransferred; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI READ CAPACITY (10) command. This command returns information about the device's capacity + * on the selected Logical Unit (drive), as a number of OS-sized blocks. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + Endpoint_Write_32_BE(LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS - 1); + Endpoint_Write_32_BE(SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= 8; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI READ (10) or WRITE (10) command. This command reads in the block start address + * and total number of blocks to process, then calls the appropriate low-level Dataflash routine to handle the actual + * reading and writing of the data. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * \param[in] IsDataRead Indicates if the command is a READ (10) command or WRITE (10) command (DATA_READ or DATA_WRITE) + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const bool IsDataRead) +{ + uint16_t BlockAddress; + uint16_t TotalBlocks; + + /* Load in the 32-bit block address (SCSI uses big-endian, so have to reverse the byte order) */ + BlockAddress = SwapEndian_32(*(uint32_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[2]); + + /* Load in the 16-bit total blocks (SCSI uses big-endian, so have to reverse the byte order) */ + TotalBlocks = SwapEndian_16(*(uint16_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[7]); + + /* Check if the block address is outside the maximum allowable value for the LUN */ + if (BlockAddress >= LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS) + { + /* Block address is invalid, update SENSE key and return command fail */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_LOGICAL_BLOCK_ADDRESS_OUT_OF_RANGE, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Determine if the packet is a READ (10) or WRITE (10) command, call appropriate function */ + for (uint16_t i = 0; i < TotalBlocks; i++) + { + if (IsDataRead == DATA_READ) + VirtualFAT_ReadBlock(BlockAddress + i); + else + VirtualFAT_WriteBlock(BlockAddress + i); + } + + /* Update the bytes transferred counter and succeed the command */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= ((uint32_t)TotalBlocks * SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES); + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI MODE SENSE (6) command. This command returns various informational pages about + * the SCSI device, as well as the device's Write Protect status. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + /* Send an empty header response indicating Write Protect flag is off */ + Endpoint_Write_32_LE(0); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Update the bytes transferred counter and succeed the command */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= 4; + + return true; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4195593363 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.h @@ -0,0 +1,84 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for SCSI.c. + */ + +#ifndef _SCSI_H_ +#define _SCSI_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "../BootloaderMassStorage.h" + #include "../Descriptors.h" + #include "VirtualFAT.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Macro to set the current SCSI sense data to the given key, additional sense code and additional sense qualifier. This + * is for convenience, as it allows for all three sense values (returned upon request to the host to give information about + * the last command failure) in a quick and easy manner. + * + * \param[in] Key New SCSI sense key to set the sense code to + * \param[in] Acode New SCSI additional sense key to set the additional sense code to + * \param[in] Aqual New SCSI additional sense key qualifier to set the additional sense qualifier code to + */ + #define SCSI_SET_SENSE(Key, Acode, Aqual) do { SenseData.SenseKey = (Key); \ + SenseData.AdditionalSenseCode = (Acode); \ + SenseData.AdditionalSenseQualifier = (Aqual); } while (0) + + /** Macro for the \ref SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10() function, to indicate that data is to be read from the storage medium. */ + #define DATA_READ true + + /** Macro for the \ref SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10() function, to indicate that data is to be written to the storage medium. */ + #define DATA_WRITE false + + /** Value for the DeviceType entry in the SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t enum, indicating a Block Media device. */ + #define DEVICE_TYPE_BLOCK 0x00 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + bool SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_SCSI_C) + static bool SCSI_Command_Inquiry(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + static bool SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + static bool SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + static bool SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const bool IsDataRead) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + static bool SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/VirtualFAT.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/VirtualFAT.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ffd453128e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/VirtualFAT.c @@ -0,0 +1,482 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Virtualized FAT12 filesystem implementation, to perform self-programming + * in response to read and write requests to the virtual filesystem by the + * host PC. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_VIRTUAL_FAT_C +#include "VirtualFAT.h" + +/** FAT filesystem boot sector block, must be the first sector on the physical + * disk so that the host can identify the presence of a FAT filesystem. This + * block is truncated; normally a large bootstrap section is located near the + * end of the block for booting purposes however as this is not meant to be a + * bootable disk it is omitted for space reasons. + * + * \note When returning the boot block to the host, the magic signature 0xAA55 + * must be added to the very end of the block to identify it as a boot + * block. + */ +static const FATBootBlock_t BootBlock = + { + .Bootstrap = {0xEB, 0x3C, 0x90}, + .Description = "mkdosfs", + .SectorSize = SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES, + .SectorsPerCluster = SECTOR_PER_CLUSTER, + .ReservedSectors = 1, + .FATCopies = 2, + .RootDirectoryEntries = (SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES / sizeof(FATDirectoryEntry_t)), + .TotalSectors16 = LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS, + .MediaDescriptor = 0xF8, + .SectorsPerFAT = 1, + .SectorsPerTrack = (LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS % 64), + .Heads = (LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS / 64), + .HiddenSectors = 0, + .TotalSectors32 = 0, + .PhysicalDriveNum = 0, + .ExtendedBootRecordSig = 0x29, + .VolumeSerialNumber = 0x12345678, + .VolumeLabel = "LUFA BOOT ", + .FilesystemIdentifier = "FAT12 ", + }; + +/** FAT 8.3 style directory entry, for the virtual FLASH contents file. */ +static FATDirectoryEntry_t FirmwareFileEntries[] = + { + /* Root volume label entry; disk label is contained in the Filename and + * Extension fields (concatenated) with a special attribute flag - other + * fields are ignored. Should be the same as the label in the boot block. + */ + [DISK_FILE_ENTRY_VolumeID] = + { + .MSDOS_Directory = + { + .Name = "LUFA BOOT ", + .Attributes = FAT_FLAG_VOLUME_NAME, + .Reserved = {0}, + .CreationTime = 0, + .CreationDate = 0, + .StartingCluster = 0, + .Reserved2 = 0, + } + }, + + /* VFAT Long File Name entry for the virtual firmware file; required to + * prevent corruption from systems that are unable to detect the device + * as being a legacy MSDOS style FAT12 volume. */ + [DISK_FILE_ENTRY_FLASH_LFN] = + { + .VFAT_LongFileName = + { + .Ordinal = 1 | FAT_ORDINAL_LAST_ENTRY, + .Attribute = FAT_FLAG_LONG_FILE_NAME, + .Reserved1 = 0, + .Reserved2 = 0, + + .Checksum = FAT_CHECKSUM('F','L','A','S','H',' ',' ',' ','B','I','N'), + + .Unicode1 = 'F', + .Unicode2 = 'L', + .Unicode3 = 'A', + .Unicode4 = 'S', + .Unicode5 = 'H', + .Unicode6 = '.', + .Unicode7 = 'B', + .Unicode8 = 'I', + .Unicode9 = 'N', + .Unicode10 = 0, + .Unicode11 = 0, + .Unicode12 = 0, + .Unicode13 = 0, + } + }, + + /* MSDOS file entry for the virtual Firmware image. */ + [DISK_FILE_ENTRY_FLASH_MSDOS] = + { + .MSDOS_File = + { + .Filename = "FLASH ", + .Extension = "BIN", + .Attributes = 0, + .Reserved = {0}, + .CreationTime = FAT_TIME(1, 1, 0), + .CreationDate = FAT_DATE(14, 2, 1989), + .StartingCluster = 2, + .FileSizeBytes = FLASH_FILE_SIZE_BYTES, + } + }, + + [DISK_FILE_ENTRY_EEPROM_LFN] = + { + .VFAT_LongFileName = + { + .Ordinal = 1 | FAT_ORDINAL_LAST_ENTRY, + .Attribute = FAT_FLAG_LONG_FILE_NAME, + .Reserved1 = 0, + .Reserved2 = 0, + + .Checksum = FAT_CHECKSUM('E','E','P','R','O','M',' ',' ','B','I','N'), + + .Unicode1 = 'E', + .Unicode2 = 'E', + .Unicode3 = 'P', + .Unicode4 = 'R', + .Unicode5 = 'O', + .Unicode6 = 'M', + .Unicode7 = '.', + .Unicode8 = 'B', + .Unicode9 = 'I', + .Unicode10 = 'N', + .Unicode11 = 0, + .Unicode12 = 0, + .Unicode13 = 0, + } + }, + + [DISK_FILE_ENTRY_EEPROM_MSDOS] = + { + .MSDOS_File = + { + .Filename = "EEPROM ", + .Extension = "BIN", + .Attributes = 0, + .Reserved = {0}, + .CreationTime = FAT_TIME(1, 1, 0), + .CreationDate = FAT_DATE(14, 2, 1989), + .StartingCluster = 2 + FILE_CLUSTERS(FLASH_FILE_SIZE_BYTES), + .FileSizeBytes = EEPROM_FILE_SIZE_BYTES, + } + }, + }; + +/** Starting cluster of the virtual FLASH.BIN file on disk, tracked so that the + * offset from the start of the data sector can be determined. On Windows + * systems files are usually replaced using the original file's disk clusters, + * while Linux appears to overwrite with an offset which must be compensated for. + */ +static const uint16_t* FLASHFileStartCluster = &FirmwareFileEntries[DISK_FILE_ENTRY_FLASH_MSDOS].MSDOS_File.StartingCluster; + +/** Starting cluster of the virtual EEPROM.BIN file on disk, tracked so that the + * offset from the start of the data sector can be determined. On Windows + * systems files are usually replaced using the original file's disk clusters, + * while Linux appears to overwrite with an offset which must be compensated for. + */ +static const uint16_t* EEPROMFileStartCluster = &FirmwareFileEntries[DISK_FILE_ENTRY_EEPROM_MSDOS].MSDOS_File.StartingCluster; + +/** Reads a byte of EEPROM out from the EEPROM memory space. + * + * \note This function is required as the avr-libc EEPROM functions do not cope + * with linker relaxations, and a jump longer than 4K of FLASH on the + * larger USB AVRs will break the linker. This function is marked as + * never inlinable and placed into the normal text segment so that the + * call to the EEPROM function will be short even if the AUX boot section + * is used. + * + * \param[in] Address Address of the EEPROM location to read from + * + * \return Read byte of EEPROM data. + */ +static uint8_t ReadEEPROMByte(const uint8_t* const Address) +{ + return eeprom_read_byte(Address); +} + +/** Writes a byte of EEPROM out to the EEPROM memory space. + * + * \note This function is required as the avr-libc EEPROM functions do not cope + * with linker relaxations, and a jump longer than 4K of FLASH on the + * larger USB AVRs will break the linker. This function is marked as + * never inlinable and placed into the normal text segment so that the + * call to the EEPROM function will be short even if the AUX boot section + * is used. + * + * \param[in] Address Address of the EEPROM location to write to + * \param[in] Data New data to write to the EEPROM location + */ +static void WriteEEPROMByte(uint8_t* const Address, + const uint8_t Data) +{ + eeprom_update_byte(Address, Data); +} + +/** Updates a FAT12 cluster entry in the FAT file table with the specified next + * chain index. If the cluster is the last in the file chain, the magic value + * \c 0xFFF should be used. + * + * \note FAT data cluster indexes are offset by 2, so that cluster 2 is the + * first file data cluster on the disk. See the FAT specification. + * + * \param[out] FATTable Pointer to the FAT12 allocation table + * \param[in] Index Index of the cluster entry to update + * \param[in] ChainEntry Next cluster index in the file chain + */ +static void UpdateFAT12ClusterEntry(uint8_t* const FATTable, + const uint16_t Index, + const uint16_t ChainEntry) +{ + /* Calculate the starting offset of the cluster entry in the FAT12 table */ + uint8_t FATOffset = (Index + (Index >> 1)); + bool UpperNibble = ((Index & 1) != 0); + + /* Check if the start of the entry is at an upper nibble of the byte, fill + * out FAT12 entry as required */ + if (UpperNibble) + { + FATTable[FATOffset] = (FATTable[FATOffset] & 0x0F) | ((ChainEntry & 0x0F) << 4); + FATTable[FATOffset + 1] = (ChainEntry >> 4); + } + else + { + FATTable[FATOffset] = ChainEntry; + FATTable[FATOffset + 1] = (FATTable[FATOffset] & 0xF0) | (ChainEntry >> 8); + } +} + +/** Updates a FAT12 cluster chain in the FAT file table with a linear chain of + * the specified length. + * + * \note FAT data cluster indexes are offset by 2, so that cluster 2 is the + * first file data cluster on the disk. See the FAT specification. + * + * \param[out] FATTable Pointer to the FAT12 allocation table + * \param[in] Index Index of the start of the cluster chain to update + * \param[in] ChainLength Length of the chain to write, in clusters + */ +static void UpdateFAT12ClusterChain(uint8_t* const FATTable, + const uint16_t Index, + const uint8_t ChainLength) +{ + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < ChainLength; i++) + { + uint16_t CurrentCluster = Index + i; + uint16_t NextCluster = CurrentCluster + 1; + + /* Mark last cluster as end of file */ + if (i == (ChainLength - 1)) + NextCluster = 0xFFF; + + UpdateFAT12ClusterEntry(FATTable, CurrentCluster, NextCluster); + } +} + +/** Reads or writes a block of data from/to the physical device FLASH using a + * block buffer stored in RAM, if the requested block is within the virtual + * firmware file's sector ranges in the emulated FAT file system. + * + * \param[in] BlockNumber Physical disk block to read from/write to + * \param[in,out] BlockBuffer Pointer to the start of the block buffer in RAM + * \param[in] Read If \c true, the requested block is read, if + * \c false, the requested block is written + */ +static void ReadWriteFLASHFileBlock(const uint16_t BlockNumber, + uint8_t* BlockBuffer, + const bool Read) +{ + uint16_t FileStartBlock = DISK_BLOCK_DataStartBlock + (*FLASHFileStartCluster - 2) * SECTOR_PER_CLUSTER; + uint16_t FileEndBlock = FileStartBlock + (FILE_SECTORS(FLASH_FILE_SIZE_BYTES) - 1); + + /* Range check the write request - abort if requested block is not within the + * virtual firmware file sector range */ + if (!((BlockNumber >= FileStartBlock) && (BlockNumber <= FileEndBlock))) + return; + + #if (FLASHEND > 0xFFFF) + uint32_t FlashAddress = (uint32_t)(BlockNumber - FileStartBlock) * SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES; + #else + uint16_t FlashAddress = (uint16_t)(BlockNumber - FileStartBlock) * SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES; + #endif + + if (Read) + { + /* Read out the mapped block of data from the device's FLASH */ + for (uint16_t i = 0; i < SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES; i++) + { + #if (FLASHEND > 0xFFFF) + BlockBuffer[i] = pgm_read_byte_far(FlashAddress++); + #else + BlockBuffer[i] = pgm_read_byte(FlashAddress++); + #endif + } + } + else + { + /* Write out the mapped block of data to the device's FLASH */ + for (uint16_t i = 0; i < SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES; i += 2) + { + if ((FlashAddress % SPM_PAGESIZE) == 0) + { + /* Erase the given FLASH page, ready to be programmed */ + BootloaderAPI_ErasePage(FlashAddress); + } + + /* Write the next data word to the FLASH page */ + BootloaderAPI_FillWord(FlashAddress, (BlockBuffer[i + 1] << 8) | BlockBuffer[i]); + FlashAddress += 2; + + if ((FlashAddress % SPM_PAGESIZE) == 0) + { + /* Write the filled FLASH page to memory */ + BootloaderAPI_WritePage(FlashAddress - SPM_PAGESIZE); + } + } + } +} + +/** Reads or writes a block of data from/to the physical device EEPROM using a + * block buffer stored in RAM, if the requested block is within the virtual + * firmware file's sector ranges in the emulated FAT file system. + * + * \param[in] BlockNumber Physical disk block to read from/write to + * \param[in,out] BlockBuffer Pointer to the start of the block buffer in RAM + * \param[in] Read If \c true, the requested block is read, if + * \c false, the requested block is written + */ +static void ReadWriteEEPROMFileBlock(const uint16_t BlockNumber, + uint8_t* BlockBuffer, + const bool Read) +{ + uint16_t FileStartBlock = DISK_BLOCK_DataStartBlock + (*EEPROMFileStartCluster - 2) * SECTOR_PER_CLUSTER; + uint16_t FileEndBlock = FileStartBlock + (FILE_SECTORS(EEPROM_FILE_SIZE_BYTES) - 1); + + /* Range check the write request - abort if requested block is not within the + * virtual firmware file sector range */ + if (!((BlockNumber >= FileStartBlock) && (BlockNumber <= FileEndBlock))) + return; + + uint16_t EEPROMAddress = (uint16_t)(BlockNumber - FileStartBlock) * SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES; + + if (Read) + { + /* Read out the mapped block of data from the device's EEPROM */ + for (uint16_t i = 0; i < SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES; i++) + BlockBuffer[i] = ReadEEPROMByte((uint8_t*)EEPROMAddress++); + } + else + { + /* Write out the mapped block of data to the device's EEPROM */ + for (uint16_t i = 0; i < SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES; i++) + WriteEEPROMByte((uint8_t*)EEPROMAddress++, BlockBuffer[i]); + } +} + +/** Writes a block of data to the virtual FAT filesystem, from the USB Mass + * Storage interface. + * + * \param[in] BlockNumber Index of the block to write. + */ +void VirtualFAT_WriteBlock(const uint16_t BlockNumber) +{ + uint8_t BlockBuffer[SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES]; + + /* Buffer the entire block to be written from the host */ + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(BlockBuffer, sizeof(BlockBuffer), NULL); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + switch (BlockNumber) + { + case DISK_BLOCK_BootBlock: + case DISK_BLOCK_FATBlock1: + case DISK_BLOCK_FATBlock2: + /* Ignore writes to the boot and FAT blocks */ + + break; + + case DISK_BLOCK_RootFilesBlock: + /* Copy over the updated directory entries */ + memcpy(FirmwareFileEntries, BlockBuffer, sizeof(FirmwareFileEntries)); + + break; + + default: + ReadWriteFLASHFileBlock(BlockNumber, BlockBuffer, false); + ReadWriteEEPROMFileBlock(BlockNumber, BlockBuffer, false); + + break; + } +} + +/** Reads a block of data from the virtual FAT filesystem, and sends it to the + * host via the USB Mass Storage interface. + * + * \param[in] BlockNumber Index of the block to read. + */ +void VirtualFAT_ReadBlock(const uint16_t BlockNumber) +{ + uint8_t BlockBuffer[SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES]; + memset(BlockBuffer, 0x00, sizeof(BlockBuffer)); + + switch (BlockNumber) + { + case DISK_BLOCK_BootBlock: + memcpy(BlockBuffer, &BootBlock, sizeof(FATBootBlock_t)); + + /* Add the magic signature to the end of the block */ + BlockBuffer[SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES - 2] = 0x55; + BlockBuffer[SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES - 1] = 0xAA; + + break; + + case DISK_BLOCK_FATBlock1: + case DISK_BLOCK_FATBlock2: + /* Cluster 0: Media type/Reserved */ + UpdateFAT12ClusterEntry(BlockBuffer, 0, 0xF00 | BootBlock.MediaDescriptor); + + /* Cluster 1: Reserved */ + UpdateFAT12ClusterEntry(BlockBuffer, 1, 0xFFF); + + /* Cluster 2 onwards: Cluster chain of FLASH.BIN */ + UpdateFAT12ClusterChain(BlockBuffer, *FLASHFileStartCluster, FILE_CLUSTERS(FLASH_FILE_SIZE_BYTES)); + + /* Cluster 2+n onwards: Cluster chain of EEPROM.BIN */ + UpdateFAT12ClusterChain(BlockBuffer, *EEPROMFileStartCluster, FILE_CLUSTERS(EEPROM_FILE_SIZE_BYTES)); + + break; + + case DISK_BLOCK_RootFilesBlock: + memcpy(BlockBuffer, FirmwareFileEntries, sizeof(FirmwareFileEntries)); + + break; + + default: + ReadWriteFLASHFileBlock(BlockNumber, BlockBuffer, true); + ReadWriteEEPROMFileBlock(BlockNumber, BlockBuffer, true); + + break; + } + + /* Write the entire read block Buffer to the host */ + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(BlockBuffer, sizeof(BlockBuffer), NULL); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/VirtualFAT.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/VirtualFAT.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ea80eae4d6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/Lib/VirtualFAT.h @@ -0,0 +1,302 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#ifndef _VIRTUALFAT_H_ +#define _VIRTUALFAT_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "../BootloaderAPI.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Size of the virtual FLASH.BIN file in bytes. */ + #define FLASH_FILE_SIZE_BYTES (FLASHEND - (FLASHEND - BOOT_START_ADDR) - AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE) + + /** Size of the virtual EEPROM.BIN file in bytes. */ + #define EEPROM_FILE_SIZE_BYTES E2END + + /** Number of sectors that comprise a single logical disk cluster. */ + #define SECTOR_PER_CLUSTER 4 + + /** Size of a single logical sector on the disk. */ + #define SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES 512 + + /** Size of a logical cluster on the disk, in bytes */ + #define CLUSTER_SIZE_BYTES (SECTOR_PER_CLUSTER * SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES) + + /** Number of sectors required to store a given size in bytes. + * + * \param[in] size Size of the data that needs to be stored + * + * \return Number of sectors required to store the given data on the disk. + */ + #define FILE_SECTORS(size) ((size / SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES) + ((size % SECTOR_SIZE_BYTES) ? 1 : 0)) + + /** Number of clusters required to store a given size in bytes. + * + * \param[in] size Size of the data that needs to be stored + * + * \return Number of clusters required to store the given data on the disk. + */ + #define FILE_CLUSTERS(size) ((size / CLUSTER_SIZE_BYTES) + ((size % CLUSTER_SIZE_BYTES) ? 1 : 0)) + + /** Total number of logical sectors/blocks on the disk. */ + #define LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS (FILE_SECTORS(FLASH_FILE_SIZE_BYTES) + FILE_SECTORS(EEPROM_FILE_SIZE_BYTES) + 32) + + /** Converts a given time in HH:MM:SS format to a FAT filesystem time. + * + * \note The minimum seconds resolution of FAT is 2, thus odd seconds + * will be truncated to the previous integer multiple of 2 seconds. + * + * \param[in] hh Hours (0-23) + * \param[in] mm Minutes (0-59) + * \param[in] ss Seconds (0-59) + * + * \return Given time encoded as a FAT filesystem timestamp + */ + #define FAT_TIME(hh, mm, ss) ((hh << 11) | (mm << 5) | (ss >> 1)) + + /** Converts a given date in DD/MM/YYYY format to a FAT filesystem date. + * + * \param[in] dd Days in the month (1-31) + * \param[in] mm Months in the year (1-12) + * \param[in] yyyy Year (1980 - 2107) + * + * \return Given date encoded as a FAT filesystem datestamp + */ + #define FAT_DATE(dd, mm, yyyy) (((yyyy - 1980) << 9) | (mm << 5) | (dd << 0)) + + /** Bit-rotates a given 8-bit value once to the right. + * + * \param[in] x Value to rotate right once + * + * \return Bit-rotated input value, rotated once to the right. + */ + #define ROT8(x) ((((x) & 0xFE) >> 1) | (((x) & 1) ? 0x80 : 0x00)) + + /** Computes the LFN entry checksum of a MSDOS 8.3 format file entry, + * to associate a LFN entry with its short file entry. + * + * \param[in] n0 MSDOS Filename character 1 + * \param[in] n1 MSDOS Filename character 2 + * \param[in] n2 MSDOS Filename character 3 + * \param[in] n3 MSDOS Filename character 4 + * \param[in] n4 MSDOS Filename character 5 + * \param[in] n5 MSDOS Filename character 6 + * \param[in] n6 MSDOS Filename character 7 + * \param[in] n7 MSDOS Filename character 8 + * \param[in] e0 MSDOS Extension character 1 + * \param[in] e1 MSDOS Extension character 2 + * \param[in] e2 MSDOS Extension character 3 + * + * \return LFN checksum of the given MSDOS 8.3 filename. + */ + #define FAT_CHECKSUM(n0, n1, n2, n3, n4, n5, n6, n7, e0, e1, e2) \ + (uint8_t)(ROT8(ROT8(ROT8(ROT8(ROT8(ROT8(ROT8(ROT8(ROT8(ROT8(n0)+n1)+n2)+n3)+n4)+n5)+n6)+n7)+e0)+e1)+e2) + + /** \name FAT Filesystem Flags */ + //@{ + /** FAT attribute flag to indicate a read-only file. */ + #define FAT_FLAG_READONLY (1 << 0) + + /** FAT attribute flag to indicate a hidden file. */ + #define FAT_FLAG_HIDDEN (1 << 1) + + /** FAT attribute flag to indicate a system file. */ + #define FAT_FLAG_SYSTEM (1 << 2) + + /** FAT attribute flag to indicate a Volume name entry. */ + #define FAT_FLAG_VOLUME_NAME (1 << 3) + + /** FAT attribute flag to indicate a directory entry. */ + #define FAT_FLAG_DIRECTORY (1 << 4) + + /** FAT attribute flag to indicate a file ready for archiving. */ + #define FAT_FLAG_ARCHIVE (1 << 5) + + /** FAT pseudo-attribute flag to indicate a Long File Name entry. */ + #define FAT_FLAG_LONG_FILE_NAME 0x0F + + /** Ordinal flag marker for FAT Long File Name entries to mark the last entry. */ + #define FAT_ORDINAL_LAST_ENTRY (1 << 6) + //@} + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the Root FAT file entry indexes on the disk. This can be used + * to retrieve the current contents of a known directory entry. + */ + enum + { + /** Volume ID directory entry, giving the name of the virtual disk. */ + DISK_FILE_ENTRY_VolumeID = 0, + /** Long File Name FAT file entry of the virtual FLASH.BIN image file. */ + DISK_FILE_ENTRY_FLASH_LFN = 1, + /** Legacy MSDOS FAT file entry of the virtual FLASH.BIN image file. */ + DISK_FILE_ENTRY_FLASH_MSDOS = 2, + /** Long File Name FAT file entry of the virtual EEPROM.BIN image file. */ + DISK_FILE_ENTRY_EEPROM_LFN = 3, + /** Legacy MSDOS FAT file entry of the virtual EEPROM.BIN image file. */ + DISK_FILE_ENTRY_EEPROM_MSDOS = 4, + }; + + /** Enum for the physical disk blocks of the virtual disk. */ + enum + { + /** Boot sector disk block. */ + DISK_BLOCK_BootBlock = 0, + /** First copy of the FAT table block. */ + DISK_BLOCK_FATBlock1 = 1, + /** Second copy of the FAT table block. */ + DISK_BLOCK_FATBlock2 = 2, + /** Root file and directory entries block. */ + DISK_BLOCK_RootFilesBlock = 3, + /** Start block of the disk data section. */ + DISK_BLOCK_DataStartBlock = 4, + }; + + /* Type Definitions: */ + /** FAT boot block structure definition, used to identify the core + * parameters of a FAT file system stored on a disk. + * + * \note This definition is truncated to save space; the magic signature + * \c 0xAA55 must be appended to the very end of the block for it + * to be detected by the host as a valid boot block. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Bootstrap[3]; + uint8_t Description[8]; + uint16_t SectorSize; + uint8_t SectorsPerCluster; + uint16_t ReservedSectors; + uint8_t FATCopies; + uint16_t RootDirectoryEntries; + uint16_t TotalSectors16; + uint8_t MediaDescriptor; + uint16_t SectorsPerFAT; + uint16_t SectorsPerTrack; + uint16_t Heads; + uint32_t HiddenSectors; + uint32_t TotalSectors32; + uint16_t PhysicalDriveNum; + uint8_t ExtendedBootRecordSig; + uint32_t VolumeSerialNumber; + uint8_t VolumeLabel[11]; + uint8_t FilesystemIdentifier[8]; + /* uint8_t BootstrapProgram[448]; */ + /* uint16_t MagicSignature; */ + } FATBootBlock_t; + + /** FAT directory entry structure, for the various kinds of File and + * directory descriptors on a FAT disk. + */ + typedef union + { + /** VFAT Long File Name file entry. */ + struct + { + uint8_t Ordinal; + uint16_t Unicode1; + uint16_t Unicode2; + uint16_t Unicode3; + uint16_t Unicode4; + uint16_t Unicode5; + uint8_t Attribute; + uint8_t Reserved1; + uint8_t Checksum; + uint16_t Unicode6; + uint16_t Unicode7; + uint16_t Unicode8; + uint16_t Unicode9; + uint16_t Unicode10; + uint16_t Unicode11; + uint16_t Reserved2; + uint16_t Unicode12; + uint16_t Unicode13; + } VFAT_LongFileName; + + /** Legacy FAT MSDOS 8.3 file entry. */ + struct + { + uint8_t Filename[8]; + uint8_t Extension[3]; + uint8_t Attributes; + uint8_t Reserved[10]; + uint16_t CreationTime; + uint16_t CreationDate; + uint16_t StartingCluster; + uint32_t FileSizeBytes; + } MSDOS_File; + + /** Legacy FAT MSDOS (sub-)directory entry. */ + struct + { + uint8_t Name[11]; + uint8_t Attributes; + uint8_t Reserved[10]; + uint16_t CreationTime; + uint16_t CreationDate; + uint16_t StartingCluster; + uint32_t Reserved2; + } MSDOS_Directory; + } FATDirectoryEntry_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_VIRTUAL_FAT_C) + static uint8_t ReadEEPROMByte(const uint8_t* const Address) ATTR_NO_INLINE; + + static void WriteEEPROMByte(uint8_t* const Address, + const uint8_t Data) ATTR_NO_INLINE; + + static void UpdateFAT12ClusterEntry(uint8_t* const FATTable, + const uint16_t Index, + const uint16_t ChainEntry) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + + static void UpdateFAT12ClusterChain(uint8_t* const FATTable, + const uint16_t StartIndex, + const uint8_t ChainLength) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + + static void ReadWriteFLASHFileBlock(const uint16_t BlockNumber, + uint8_t* BlockBuffer, + const bool Read) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + + static void ReadWriteEEPROMFileBlock(const uint16_t BlockNumber, + uint8_t* BlockBuffer, + const bool Read) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + #endif + + void VirtualFAT_WriteBlock(const uint16_t BlockNumber) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + void VirtualFAT_ReadBlock(const uint16_t BlockNumber) AUX_BOOT_SECTION; + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f1d550d1eb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,156 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Mass Storage Bootloader - 128KB FLASH / 8KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.mass_storage.avr8.128_8" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_ms_128kb_8kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.mass_storage"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x1E000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x1E000"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE" value="0"/>
+
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x1FFA0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x1FFE0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x1FFF8"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Mass Storage Bootloader - 64KB FLASH / 8KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.mass_storage.avr8.64_8" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_ms_64kb_8kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.mass_storage"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb647"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0xE000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0xE000"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE" value="0"/>
+
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0xFFA0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0xFFE0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0xFFF8"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Mass Storage Bootloader - 32KB FLASH / 4KB Boot (2KB AUX) - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.mass_storage.avr8.32_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_ms_32kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.mass_storage"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u4"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x7000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x7000"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE" value="2048"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.boot_aux=0x6810"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.boot_aux_trampoline=0x6800"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=Boot_AUX_Trampoline"/>
+
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x7FA0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x7FE0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x7FF8"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Mass Storage Bootloader - 16KB FLASH / 4KB Boot (2KB AUX) - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.mass_storage.avr8.16_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_ms_16kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.mass_storage"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega16u2"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x3000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x3000"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE" value="2048"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.boot_aux=0x2810"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.boot_aux_trampoline=0x2800"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=Boot_AUX_Trampoline"/>
+
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x3FA0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x3FE0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x3FF8"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.bootloaders.mass_storage" caption="Mass Storage Bootloader">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Mass Storage Class Bootloader, capable of reprogramming a device via binary BIN files copied to the virtual FAT12 file-system it creates when plugged into a host.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Bootloaders"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value="."/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="BootloaderMassStorage.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="BootloaderMassStorage.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="BootloaderAPI.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="BootloaderAPI.h"/>
+ <build type="asm-source" value="BootloaderAPITable.S"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value="Lib"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/VirtualFAT.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/VirtualFAT.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/SCSI.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/SCSI.c"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="BootloaderMassStorage.txt"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..795c6e81ad --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2396 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Mass Storage Class Bootloader" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM \ + ATTR_NO_INIT + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/makefile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7f0ec82a7f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/MassStorage/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,75 @@ +#
+# LUFA Library
+# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+#
+# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+# www.lufa-lib.org
+#
+# --------------------------------------
+# LUFA Project Makefile.
+# --------------------------------------
+
+# Run "make help" for target help.
+
+MCU = at90usb1287
+ARCH = AVR8
+BOARD = USBKEY
+F_CPU = 8000000
+F_USB = $(F_CPU)
+OPTIMIZATION = s
+TARGET = BootloaderMassStorage
+SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c BootloaderAPI.c BootloaderAPITable.S Lib/SCSI.c Lib/VirtualFAT.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)
+LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA
+CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ -DBOOT_START_ADDR=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET)
+LD_FLAGS = -Wl,--section-start=.text=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET) $(BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS)
+
+# Flash size and bootloader section sizes of the target, in KB. These must
+# match the target's total FLASH size and the bootloader size set in the
+# device's fuses.
+FLASH_SIZE_KB = 128
+BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB = 8
+
+# Bootloader address calculation formulas
+# Do not modify these macros, but rather modify the dependent values above.
+CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX = $(shell printf "0x%X" $$(( $(1) )) )
+BOOT_START_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) - $(BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB)) * 1024 )
+BOOT_SEC_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) * 1024) - ($(strip $(1))) )
+
+# Bootloader linker section flags for relocating the API table sections to
+# known FLASH addresses - these should not normally be user-edited.
+BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG = -Wl,--section-start=$(strip $(1))=$(call BOOT_SEC_OFFSET, $(3)) -Wl,--undefined=$(strip $(2))
+BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS = $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_trampolines, BootloaderAPI_Trampolines, 96)
+BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS += $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_jumptable, BootloaderAPI_JumpTable, 32)
+BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS += $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_signatures, BootloaderAPI_Signatures, 8)
+
+# Check if the bootloader needs an AUX section, located before the real bootloader section to store some of the
+# bootloader code. This is required for 32KB and smaller devices, where the actual bootloader is 6KB but the maximum
+# bootloader section size is 4KB. The actual usable application space will be reduced by 6KB for these devices.
+ifeq ($(BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB),8)
+ CC_FLAGS += -DAUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE=0
+else
+ AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB = (6 - $(BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB))
+
+ CC_FLAGS += -DAUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE='($(AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB) * 1024)'
+ LD_FLAGS += -Wl,--section-start=.boot_aux=$(call BOOT_SEC_OFFSET, (($(BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB) + $(AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB)) * 1024 - 16))
+ LD_FLAGS += $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .boot_aux_trampoline, Boot_AUX_Trampoline, ($(BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB) + $(AUX_BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB)) * 1024)
+endif
+
+# Default target
+all:
+
+# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules
+DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA
+include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk
+include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk
+
+# Include common DMBS build system modules
+DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS
+include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk
+include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk
+include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk
+include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk
+include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk
+include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk
+include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk
+include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderAPI.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderAPI.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2be1568082 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderAPI.c @@ -0,0 +1,75 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Bootloader user application API functions. + */ + +#include "BootloaderAPI.h" + +void BootloaderAPI_ErasePage(const uint32_t Address) +{ + boot_page_erase_safe(Address); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + boot_rww_enable(); +} + +void BootloaderAPI_WritePage(const uint32_t Address) +{ + boot_page_write_safe(Address); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + boot_rww_enable(); +} + +void BootloaderAPI_FillWord(const uint32_t Address, const uint16_t Word) +{ + boot_page_fill_safe(Address, Word); +} + +uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature(const uint16_t Address) +{ + return boot_signature_byte_get(Address); +} + +uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse(const uint16_t Address) +{ + return boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(Address); +} + +uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadLock(void) +{ + return boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_LOCK_BITS); +} + +void BootloaderAPI_WriteLock(const uint8_t LockBits) +{ + boot_lock_bits_set_safe(LockBits); +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderAPI.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderAPI.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c2d9b4a188 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderAPI.h @@ -0,0 +1,56 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for BootloaderAPI.c. + */ + +#ifndef _BOOTLOADER_API_H_ +#define _BOOTLOADER_API_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/boot.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void BootloaderAPI_ErasePage(const uint32_t Address); + void BootloaderAPI_WritePage(const uint32_t Address); + void BootloaderAPI_FillWord(const uint32_t Address, const uint16_t Word); + uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature(const uint16_t Address); + uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse(const uint16_t Address); + uint8_t BootloaderAPI_ReadLock(void); + void BootloaderAPI_WriteLock(const uint8_t LockBits); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderAPITable.S b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderAPITable.S new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..76f37bf499 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderAPITable.S @@ -0,0 +1,91 @@ +/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+*/
+
+/*
+ Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+ Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this
+ software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted
+ without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in
+ all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+ permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+ documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+ advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+ software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+ The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this
+ software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+ and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
+ special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+ whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+ in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+ arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+ this software.
+*/
+
+; Trampolines to actual API implementations if the target address is outside the
+; range of a rjmp instruction (can happen with large bootloader sections)
+.section .apitable_trampolines, "ax"
+.global BootloaderAPI_Trampolines
+BootloaderAPI_Trampolines:
+
+ BootloaderAPI_ErasePage_Trampoline:
+ jmp BootloaderAPI_ErasePage
+ BootloaderAPI_WritePage_Trampoline:
+ jmp BootloaderAPI_WritePage
+ BootloaderAPI_FillWord_Trampoline:
+ jmp BootloaderAPI_FillWord
+ BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature_Trampoline:
+ jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature
+ BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse_Trampoline:
+ jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse
+ BootloaderAPI_ReadLock_Trampoline:
+ jmp BootloaderAPI_ReadLock
+ BootloaderAPI_WriteLock_Trampoline:
+ jmp BootloaderAPI_WriteLock
+ BootloaderAPI_UNUSED1:
+ ret
+ BootloaderAPI_UNUSED2:
+ ret
+ BootloaderAPI_UNUSED3:
+ ret
+ BootloaderAPI_UNUSED4:
+ ret
+ BootloaderAPI_UNUSED5:
+ ret
+
+
+
+; API function jump table
+.section .apitable_jumptable, "ax"
+.global BootloaderAPI_JumpTable
+BootloaderAPI_JumpTable:
+
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_ErasePage_Trampoline
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_WritePage_Trampoline
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_FillWord_Trampoline
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature_Trampoline
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse_Trampoline
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_ReadLock_Trampoline
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_WriteLock_Trampoline
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED1 ; UNUSED ENTRY 1
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED2 ; UNUSED ENTRY 2
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED3 ; UNUSED ENTRY 3
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED4 ; UNUSED ENTRY 4
+ rjmp BootloaderAPI_UNUSED5 ; UNUSED ENTRY 5
+
+
+
+; Bootloader table signatures and information
+.section .apitable_signatures, "ax"
+.global BootloaderAPI_Signatures
+BootloaderAPI_Signatures:
+
+ .long BOOT_START_ADDR ; Start address of the bootloader
+ .word 0xDF20 ; Signature for the Printer class bootloader
+ .word 0xDCFB ; Signature for a LUFA class bootloader
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderPrinter.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderPrinter.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9021f998f7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderPrinter.c @@ -0,0 +1,487 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the Printer class bootloader. This file contains the complete bootloader logic. + */ + +#include "BootloaderPrinter.h" + +/** LUFA Printer Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all Printer Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t TextOnly_Printer_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Printer, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = PRINTER_IN_EPADDR, + .Size = PRINTER_IO_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = PRINTER_OUT_EPADDR, + .Size = PRINTER_IO_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .IEEE1284String = + "MFG:Generic;" + "MDL:Generic_/_Text_Only;" + "CMD:1284.4;" + "CLS:PRINTER", + }, + }; + +/** Intel HEX parser state machine state information, to track the contents of + * a HEX file streamed in as a sequence of arbitrary bytes. + */ +struct +{ + /** Current HEX parser state machine state. */ + uint8_t ParserState; + /** Previously decoded numerical byte of data. */ + uint8_t PrevData; + /** Currently decoded numerical byte of data. */ + uint8_t Data; + /** Indicates if both bytes that correspond to a single decoded numerical + * byte of data (HEX encodes values in ASCII HEX, two characters per byte) + * have been read. + */ + bool ReadMSB; + /** Intel HEX record type of the current Intel HEX record. */ + uint8_t RecordType; + /** Numerical bytes of data remaining to be read in the current record. */ + uint8_t DataRem; + /** Checksum of the current record received so far. */ + uint8_t Checksum; + /** Starting address of the last addressed FLASH page. */ + uint32_t PageStartAddress; + /** Current 32-bit byte extended base address in FLASH being targeted. */ + uint32_t CurrBaseAddress; + /** Current 32-bit byte address in FLASH being targeted. */ + uint32_t CurrAddress; +} HEXParser; + +/** Indicates if there is data waiting to be written to a physical page of + * memory in FLASH. + */ +static bool PageDirty = false; + +/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader should be running, or should exit and allow the application code to run + * via a soft reset. When cleared, the bootloader will abort, the USB interface will shut down and the application + * started via a forced watchdog reset. + */ +static bool RunBootloader = true; + +/** Magic lock for forced application start. If the HWBE fuse is programmed and BOOTRST is unprogrammed, the bootloader + * will start if the /HWB line of the AVR is held low and the system is reset. However, if the /HWB line is still held + * low when the application attempts to start via a watchdog reset, the bootloader will re-start. If set to the value + * \ref MAGIC_BOOT_KEY the special init function \ref Application_Jump_Check() will force the application to start. + */ +uint16_t MagicBootKey ATTR_NO_INIT; + + +/** Special startup routine to check if the bootloader was started via a watchdog reset, and if the magic application + * start key has been loaded into \ref MagicBootKey. If the bootloader started via the watchdog and the key is valid, + * this will force the user application to start via a software jump. + */ +void Application_Jump_Check(void) +{ + bool JumpToApplication = false; + + #if (BOARD == BOARD_LEONARDO) + /* Enable pull-up on the IO13 pin so we can use it to select the mode */ + PORTC |= (1 << 7); + Delay_MS(10); + + /* If IO13 is not jumpered to ground, start the user application instead */ + JumpToApplication = ((PINC & (1 << 7)) != 0); + + /* Disable pull-up after the check has completed */ + PORTC &= ~(1 << 7); + #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + /* Disable JTAG debugging */ + JTAG_DISABLE(); + + /* Enable pull-up on the JTAG TCK pin so we can use it to select the mode */ + PORTF |= (1 << 4); + Delay_MS(10); + + /* If the TCK pin is not jumpered to ground, start the user application instead */ + JumpToApplication = ((PINF & (1 << 4)) != 0); + + /* Re-enable JTAG debugging */ + JTAG_ENABLE(); + #else + /* Check if the device's BOOTRST fuse is set */ + if (boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_HIGH_FUSE_BITS) & FUSE_BOOTRST) + { + /* If the reset source was not an external reset or the key is correct, clear it and jump to the application */ + if (!(MCUSR & (1 << EXTRF)) || (MagicBootKey == MAGIC_BOOT_KEY)) + JumpToApplication = true; + + /* Clear reset source */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << EXTRF); + } + else + { + /* If the reset source was the bootloader and the key is correct, clear it and jump to the application; + * this can happen in the HWBE fuse is set, and the HBE pin is low during the watchdog reset */ + if ((MCUSR & (1 << WDRF)) && (MagicBootKey == MAGIC_BOOT_KEY)) + JumpToApplication = true; + + /* Clear reset source */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + } + #endif + + /* Don't run the user application if the reset vector is blank (no app loaded) */ + bool ApplicationValid = (pgm_read_word_near(0) != 0xFFFF); + + /* If a request has been made to jump to the user application, honor it */ + if (JumpToApplication && ApplicationValid) + { + /* Turn off the watchdog */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Clear the boot key and jump to the user application */ + MagicBootKey = 0; + + // cppcheck-suppress constStatement + ((void (*)(void))0x0000)(); + } +} + +/** + * Converts a given input byte of data from an ASCII encoded HEX value to an integer value. + * + * \note Input HEX bytes are expected to be in uppercase only. + * + * \param[in] Byte ASCII byte of data to convert + * + * \return Integer converted value of the input ASCII encoded HEX byte of data, or -1 if the + * input is not valid ASCII encoded HEX. + */ +static int8_t HexToDecimal(const char Byte) +{ + if ((Byte >= 'A') && (Byte <= 'F')) + return (10 + (Byte - 'A')); + else if ((Byte >= '0') && (Byte <= '9')) + return (Byte - '0'); + + return -1; +} + +/** + * Flushes a partially written page of data to physical FLASH, if a page + * boundary has been crossed. + * + * \note If a page flush occurs the global HEX parser state is updated. + */ +static void FlushPageIfRequired(void) +{ + /* Abort if no data has been buffered for writing to the current page */ + if (!PageDirty) + return; + + /* Flush the FLASH page to physical memory if we are crossing a page boundary */ + uint32_t NewPageStartAddress = (HEXParser.CurrAddress & ~(SPM_PAGESIZE - 1)); + if (HEXParser.PageStartAddress != NewPageStartAddress) + { + boot_page_write(HEXParser.PageStartAddress); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + + HEXParser.PageStartAddress = NewPageStartAddress; + + PageDirty = false; + } +} + +/** + * Parses an input Intel HEX formatted stream one character at a time, loading + * the data contents into the device's internal FLASH memory. + * + * \param[in] ReadCharacter Next input ASCII byte of data to parse + */ +static void ParseIntelHEXByte(const char ReadCharacter) +{ + /* Reset the line parser while waiting for a new line to start */ + if ((HEXParser.ParserState == HEX_PARSE_STATE_WAIT_LINE) || (ReadCharacter == ':')) + { + HEXParser.Checksum = 0; + HEXParser.CurrAddress = HEXParser.CurrBaseAddress; + HEXParser.ReadMSB = false; + + /* ASCII ':' indicates the start of a new HEX record */ + if (ReadCharacter == ':') + HEXParser.ParserState = HEX_PARSE_STATE_BYTE_COUNT; + + return; + } + + /* Only allow ASCII HEX encoded digits, ignore all other characters */ + int8_t ReadCharacterDec = HexToDecimal(ReadCharacter); + if (ReadCharacterDec < 0) + return; + + /* Read and convert the next nibble of data from the current character */ + HEXParser.Data = (HEXParser.Data << 4) | ReadCharacterDec; + HEXParser.ReadMSB = !HEXParser.ReadMSB; + + /* Only process further when a full byte (two nibbles) have been read */ + if (HEXParser.ReadMSB) + return; + + /* Intel HEX checksum is for all fields except starting character and the + * checksum itself + */ + if (HEXParser.ParserState != HEX_PARSE_STATE_CHECKSUM) + HEXParser.Checksum += HEXParser.Data; + + switch (HEXParser.ParserState) + { + case HEX_PARSE_STATE_BYTE_COUNT: + HEXParser.DataRem = HEXParser.Data; + HEXParser.ParserState = HEX_PARSE_STATE_ADDRESS_HIGH; + break; + + case HEX_PARSE_STATE_ADDRESS_HIGH: + HEXParser.CurrAddress += ((uint16_t)HEXParser.Data << 8); + HEXParser.ParserState = HEX_PARSE_STATE_ADDRESS_LOW; + break; + + case HEX_PARSE_STATE_ADDRESS_LOW: + HEXParser.CurrAddress += HEXParser.Data; + HEXParser.ParserState = HEX_PARSE_STATE_RECORD_TYPE; + break; + + case HEX_PARSE_STATE_RECORD_TYPE: + HEXParser.RecordType = HEXParser.Data; + HEXParser.ParserState = (HEXParser.DataRem ? HEX_PARSE_STATE_READ_DATA : HEX_PARSE_STATE_CHECKSUM); + break; + + case HEX_PARSE_STATE_READ_DATA: + /* Track the number of read data bytes in the record */ + HEXParser.DataRem--; + + /* Protect the bootloader against being written to */ + if (HEXParser.CurrAddress >= BOOT_START_ADDR) + { + HEXParser.ParserState = HEX_PARSE_STATE_WAIT_LINE; + PageDirty = false; + return; + } + + /* Wait for a machine word (two bytes) of data to be read */ + if (HEXParser.DataRem & 0x01) + { + HEXParser.PrevData = HEXParser.Data; + break; + } + + /* Convert the last two received data bytes into a 16-bit word */ + uint16_t NewDataWord = ((uint16_t)HEXParser.Data << 8) | HEXParser.PrevData; + + switch (HEXParser.RecordType) + { + case HEX_RECORD_TYPE_Data: + /* If we are writing to a new page, we need to erase it first */ + if (!(PageDirty)) + { + boot_page_erase(HEXParser.PageStartAddress); + boot_spm_busy_wait(); + + PageDirty = true; + } + + /* Fill the FLASH memory buffer with the new word of data */ + boot_page_fill(HEXParser.CurrAddress, NewDataWord); + HEXParser.CurrAddress += 2; + + /* Flush the FLASH page to physical memory if we are crossing a page boundary */ + FlushPageIfRequired(); + break; + + case HEX_RECORD_TYPE_ExtendedSegmentAddress: + /* Extended address data - store the upper 12-bits of the new address */ + HEXParser.CurrBaseAddress = ((uint32_t)NewDataWord << 4); + break; + + case HEX_RECORD_TYPE_ExtendedLinearAddress: + /* Extended address data - store the upper 16-bits of the new address */ + HEXParser.CurrBaseAddress = ((uint32_t)NewDataWord << 16); + break; + } + + if (!HEXParser.DataRem) + HEXParser.ParserState = HEX_PARSE_STATE_CHECKSUM; + break; + + case HEX_PARSE_STATE_CHECKSUM: + /* Verify checksum of the completed record */ + if (HEXParser.Data != ((~HEXParser.Checksum + 1) & 0xFF)) + break; + + /* Flush the FLASH page to physical memory if we are crossing a page boundary */ + FlushPageIfRequired(); + + /* If end of the HEX file reached, the bootloader should exit at next opportunity */ + if (HEXParser.RecordType == HEX_RECORD_TYPE_EndOfFile) + RunBootloader = false; + + break; + + default: + HEXParser.ParserState = HEX_PARSE_STATE_WAIT_LINE; + break; + } +} + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + while (RunBootloader) + { + uint8_t BytesReceived = PRNT_Device_BytesReceived(&TextOnly_Printer_Interface); + + if (BytesReceived) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + + while (BytesReceived--) + { + int16_t ReceivedByte = PRNT_Device_ReceiveByte(&TextOnly_Printer_Interface); + + /* Feed the next byte of data to the HEX parser */ + ParseIntelHEXByte(ReceivedByte); + } + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + } + + PRNT_Device_USBTask(&TextOnly_Printer_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } + + /* Disconnect from the host - USB interface will be reset later along with the AVR */ + USB_Detach(); + + /* Unlock the forced application start mode of the bootloader if it is restarted */ + MagicBootKey = MAGIC_BOOT_KEY; + + /* Enable the watchdog and force a timeout to reset the AVR */ + wdt_enable(WDTO_250MS); + + for (;;); +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +static void SetupHardware(void) +{ + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); + + /* Relocate the interrupt vector table to the bootloader section */ + MCUCR = (1 << IVCE); + MCUCR = (1 << IVSEL); + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Bootloader active LED toggle timer initialization */ + TIMSK1 = (1 << TOIE1); + TCCR1B = ((1 << CS11) | (1 << CS10)); +} + +/** ISR to periodically toggle the LEDs on the board to indicate that the bootloader is active. */ +ISR(TIMER1_OVF_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB enumerating */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via + * the status LEDs and stops the Printer management task. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB not ready */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This is fired when the host set the current configuration + * of the USB device after enumeration - the device endpoints are configured and the Mass Storage management task started. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + /* Setup Printer Data Endpoints */ + ConfigSuccess &= PRNT_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&TextOnly_Printer_Interface); + + /* Reset the HEX parser upon successful connection to a host */ + HEXParser.ParserState = HEX_PARSE_STATE_WAIT_LINE; + + /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to + * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing + * internally. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + PRNT_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&TextOnly_Printer_Interface); +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderPrinter.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderPrinter.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8bc1a68799 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderPrinter.h @@ -0,0 +1,108 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for BootloaderPrinter.c. + */ + +#ifndef _BOOTLOADER_PRINTER_H_ +#define _BOOTLOADER_PRINTER_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__OPTIMIZE_SIZE__) + #error This bootloader requires that it be optimized for size, not speed, to fit into the target device. Change optimization settings and try again. + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 + + /** Magic bootloader key to unlock forced application start mode. */ + #define MAGIC_BOOT_KEY 0xDC42 + + /* Enums: */ + /** Intel HEX parser state machine states. */ + enum HEX_Parser_States_t + { + HEX_PARSE_STATE_WAIT_LINE, /**< Parser is waiting for a HEX Start of Line character. */ + HEX_PARSE_STATE_BYTE_COUNT, /**< Parser is waiting for a record byte count. */ + HEX_PARSE_STATE_ADDRESS_HIGH, /**< Parser is waiting for the MSB of a record address. */ + HEX_PARSE_STATE_ADDRESS_LOW, /**< Parser is waiting for the LSB of a record address. */ + HEX_PARSE_STATE_RECORD_TYPE, /**< Parser is waiting for the record type. */ + HEX_PARSE_STATE_READ_DATA, /**< Parser is waiting for more data in the current record. */ + HEX_PARSE_STATE_CHECKSUM, /**< Parser is waiting for the checksum of the current record. */ + }; + + /** Intel HEX record types, used to indicate the type of record contained in a line of a HEX file. */ + enum HEX_Record_Types_t + { + HEX_RECORD_TYPE_Data = 0, /**< Record contains loadable data. */ + HEX_RECORD_TYPE_EndOfFile = 1, /**< End of file record. */ + HEX_RECORD_TYPE_ExtendedSegmentAddress = 2, /**< Extended segment start record. */ + HEX_RECORD_TYPE_StartSegmentAddress = 3, /**< Normal segment start record. */ + HEX_RECORD_TYPE_ExtendedLinearAddress = 4, /**< Extended linear address start record. */ + HEX_RECORD_TYPE_StartLinearAddress = 5, /**< Linear address start record. */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + static void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderPrinter.txt b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderPrinter.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d9aa79686f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/BootloaderPrinter.txt @@ -0,0 +1,202 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Printer Class USB AVR Bootloader + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Printer Class</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Printer Subclass</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Printer Class Standard</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * This bootloader enumerates to the host as a Generic Text Only Printer device, capable of reading and parsing + * "printed" plain-text Intel HEX files to load firmware onto the AVR. + * + * Out of the box this bootloader builds for the AT90USB1287 with an 8KB bootloader section size, and will fit + * into 4KB of bootloader space. If you wish to alter this size and/or change the AVR model, you will need to + * edit the MCU, FLASH_SIZE_KB and BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB values in the accompanying makefile. + * + * When the bootloader is running, the board's LED(s) will flash at regular intervals to distinguish the + * bootloader from the normal user application. + * + * \section Sec_Running Running the Bootloader + * + * On the USB AVR8 devices, setting the \c HWBE device fuse will cause the bootloader to run if the \c HWB pin of + * the AVR is grounded when the device is reset. + * + * The are two behaviours of this bootloader, depending on the device's fuses: + * + * <b>If the device's BOOTRST fuse is set</b>, the bootloader will run any time the system is reset from + * the external reset pin, unless no valid user application has been loaded. To initiate the bootloader, the + * device's external reset pin should be grounded momentarily. + * + * <b>If the device's BOOTRST fuse is not set</b>, the bootloader will run only if initiated via a software + * jump, or if the \c HWB pin was low during the last device reset (if the \c HWBE fuse is set). + * + * For board specific exceptions to the above, see below. + * + * \subsection SSec_XPLAIN Atmel Xplain Board + * Ground the USB AVR JTAG's \c TCK pin to ground when powering on the board to start the bootloader. This assumes the + * \c HWBE fuse is cleared and the \c BOOTRST fuse is set as the HWBE pin is not user accessible on this board. + * + * \subsection SSec_Leonardo Arduino Leonardo Board + * Ground \c IO13 when powering the board to start the bootloader. This assumes the \c HWBE fuse is cleared and the + * \c BOOTRST fuse is set as the HWBE pin is not user accessible on this board. + * + * \section Sec_Installation Driver Installation + * + * This bootloader uses the Generic Text-Only printer drivers inbuilt into all modern operating systems, thus no + * additional drivers need to be supplied for correct operation. + * + * \section Sec_HostApp Host Controller Application + * + * This bootloader is compatible with Notepad under Windows, and the command line \c lpr utility under Linux. + * + * \subsection SSec_Notepad Notepad (Windows) + * + * While most text applications under Windows will be compatible with the bootloader, the inbuilt Notepad utility + * is recommended as it will introduce minimal formatting changes to the output stream. To program with Notepad, + * open the target HEX file and print it to the Generic Text Only printer device the bootloader creates. + * + * \subsection SSec_LPR LPR (Linux) + * + * While the CUPS framework under Linux will enumerate the bootloader as a Generic Text-Only printer, many + * applications will refuse to print to the device due to the lack of rich formatting options available. As a result, + * under Linux HEX files must be printed via the low level \c lpr utility instead. + * + * \code + * cat Mouse.hex | lpr + * \endcode + * + * \section Sec_API User Application API + * + * Several user application functions for FLASH and other special memory area manipulations are exposed by the bootloader, + * allowing the user application to call into the bootloader at runtime to read and write FLASH data. + * + * By default, the bootloader API jump table is located 32 bytes from the end of the device's FLASH memory, and follows the + * following layout: + * + * \code + * #define BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE 32 + * #define BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START ((FLASHEND + 1UL) - BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE) + * #define BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(Index) (void*)((BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (Index * 2)) / 2) + * + * void (*BootloaderAPI_ErasePage)(uint32_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(0); + * void (*BootloaderAPI_WritePage)(uint32_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(1); + * void (*BootloaderAPI_FillWord)(uint32_t Address, uint16_t Word) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(2); + * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadSignature)(uint16_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(3); + * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadFuse)(uint16_t Address) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(4); + * uint8_t (*BootloaderAPI_ReadLock)(void) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(5); + * void (*BootloaderAPI_WriteLock)(uint8_t LockBits) = BOOTLOADER_API_CALL(6); + * + * #define BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 2)) + * #define BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE 0xDCFB + * + * #define BOOTLOADER_CLASS_SIGNATURE_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 4)) + * #define BOOTLOADER_PRINTER_SIGNATURE 0xDF20 + * + * #define BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_START (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_START + (BOOTLOADER_API_TABLE_SIZE - 8)) + * #define BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_LENGTH 4 + * \endcode + * + * From the application the API support of the bootloader can be detected by reading the FLASH memory bytes located at address + * \c BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE_START and comparing them to the value \c BOOTLOADER_MAGIC_SIGNATURE. The class of bootloader + * can be determined by reading the FLASH memory bytes located at address \c BOOTLOADER_CLASS_SIGNATURE_START and comparing them + * to the value \c BOOTLOADER_PRINTER_SIGNATURE. The start address of the bootloader can be retrieved by reading the bytes of FLASH + * memory starting from address \c BOOTLOADER_ADDRESS_START. + * + * \subsection SSec_API_MemLayout Device Memory Map + * The following illustration indicates the final memory map of the device when loaded with the bootloader. + * + * \verbatim + * +----------------------------+ 0x0000 + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | User Application | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * | | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - BOOT_SECTION_SIZE + * | | + * | Bootloader Application | + * | (Not User App. Accessible) | + * | | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 96 + * | API Table Trampolines | + * | (Not User App. Accessible) | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 32 + * | Bootloader API Table | + * | (User App. Accessible) | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND - 8 + * | Bootloader ID Constants | + * | (User App. Accessible) | + * +----------------------------+ FLASHEND + * \endverbatim + * + * + * \section Sec_KnownIssues Known Issues: + * + * \par On Linux machines, new firmware fails to be sent to the device via CUPS. + * Only a limited subset of normal printer functionality is exposed via the + * bootloader, causing CUPS to reject print requests from applications that + * are unable to handle true plain-text printing. For best results, the low + * level \c lpr command should be used to print new firmware to the bootloader. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5aa0e765bf --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT + #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS + #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 + #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT + #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP + #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..99625d605a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,194 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x206B, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED, + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .Printer_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Printer, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = PRNT_CSCP_PrinterClass, + .SubClass = PRNT_CSCP_PrinterSubclass, + .Protocol = PRNT_CSCP_BidirectionalProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Printer_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = PRINTER_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = PRINTER_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .Printer_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = PRINTER_OUT_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = PRINTER_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Printer Bootloader"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = LanguageString.Header.Size; + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = ManufacturerString.Header.Size; + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = ProductString.Header.Size; + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..adb0dddb64 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,96 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Printer device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define PRINTER_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the Printer host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define PRINTER_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) + + /** Size in bytes of the Printer data endpoints. */ + #define PRINTER_IO_EPSIZE 64 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Printer Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Printer_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t Printer_DataInEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t Printer_DataOutEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_Printer = 0, /**< Printer interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..86a56911ed --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,159 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Printer Bootloader - 128KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.printer.avr8.128_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_printer_128kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.printer"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x1F000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x1F000"/>
+
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x1FFA0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x1FFE0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x1FFF8"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Printer Bootloader - 64KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.printer.avr8.64_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_printer_64kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.printer"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb647"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0xF000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0xF000"/>
+
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0xFFA0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0xFFE0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0xFFF8"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Printer Bootloader - 32KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.printer.avr8.32_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_printer_32kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.printer"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u4"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x7000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x7000"/>
+
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x7FA0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x7FE0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x7FF8"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Printer Bootloader - 16KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.printer.avr8.16_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_printer_16kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.printer"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega16u2"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x3000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x3000"/>
+
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x3FA0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x3FE0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x3FF8"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Printer Bootloader - 8KB FLASH / 4KB Boot - AVR8 Architecture" id="lufa.bootloaders.printer.avr8.8_4" force-caption="true" workspace-name="lufa_printer_8kb_4kb_">
+ <require idref="lufa.bootloaders.printer"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega8u2"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <config name="config.compiler.optimization.level" value="size"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOOT_START_ADDR" value="0x1000"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.text=0x1000"/>
+
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_trampolines=0x1FA0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Trampolines"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_jumptable=0x1FE0"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_JumpTable"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--section-start=.apitable_signatures=0x1FF8"/>
+ <build type="linker-config" subtype="flags" value="--undefined=BootloaderAPI_Signatures"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.bootloaders.printer" caption="Printer Bootloader">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Printer Class Bootloader, capable of reprogramming a device by "printing" new HEX files to the virtual Plain-Text printer it creates when plugged into a host.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Bootloaders"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value="."/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="BootloaderPrinter.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="BootloaderPrinter.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="BootloaderAPI.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="BootloaderAPI.h"/>
+ <build type="asm-source" value="BootloaderAPITable.S"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="BootloaderPrinter.txt"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0f96bb9b73 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2396 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Printer Class Bootloader" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM \ + ATTR_NO_INIT + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/makefile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2c8582ca22 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/Printer/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +#
+# LUFA Library
+# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+#
+# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+# www.lufa-lib.org
+#
+# --------------------------------------
+# LUFA Project Makefile.
+# --------------------------------------
+
+# Run "make help" for target help.
+
+MCU = at90usb1287
+ARCH = AVR8
+BOARD = USBKEY
+F_CPU = 8000000
+F_USB = $(F_CPU)
+OPTIMIZATION = s
+TARGET = BootloaderPrinter
+SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c BootloaderAPI.c BootloaderAPITable.S $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)
+LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA
+CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ -DBOOT_START_ADDR=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET)
+LD_FLAGS = -Wl,--section-start=.text=$(BOOT_START_OFFSET) $(BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS)
+
+# Flash size and bootloader section sizes of the target, in KB. These must
+# match the target's total FLASH size and the bootloader size set in the
+# device's fuses.
+FLASH_SIZE_KB = 128
+BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB = 8
+
+# Bootloader address calculation formulas
+# Do not modify these macros, but rather modify the dependent values above.
+CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX = $(shell printf "0x%X" $$(( $(1) )) )
+BOOT_START_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) - $(BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB)) * 1024 )
+BOOT_SEC_OFFSET = $(call CALC_ADDRESS_IN_HEX, ($(FLASH_SIZE_KB) * 1024) - ($(strip $(1))) )
+
+# Bootloader linker section flags for relocating the API table sections to
+# known FLASH addresses - these should not normally be user-edited.
+BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG = -Wl,--section-start=$(strip $(1))=$(call BOOT_SEC_OFFSET, $(3)) -Wl,--undefined=$(strip $(2))
+BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS = $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_trampolines, BootloaderAPI_Trampolines, 96)
+BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS += $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_jumptable, BootloaderAPI_JumpTable, 32)
+BOOT_API_LD_FLAGS += $(call BOOT_SECTION_LD_FLAG, .apitable_signatures, BootloaderAPI_Signatures, 8)
+
+# Default target
+all:
+
+# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules
+DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA
+include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk
+include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk
+
+# Include common DMBS build system modules
+DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS
+include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk
+include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk
+include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk
+include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk
+include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk
+include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk
+include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk
+include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/makefile b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e030ad44ab --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Bootloaders/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,46 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +# Makefile to build all the LUFA USB Bootloaders. Call with "make all" to +# rebuild all bootloaders. + +# Bootloaders are pre-cleaned before each one is built, to ensure any +# custom LUFA library build options are reflected in the compiled +# code. + +PROJECT_DIRECTORIES := $(shell ls -d */) + +# This makefile is potentially infinitely recursive if something really bad +# happens when determining the set of project directories - hard-abort if +# more than 10 levels deep to avoid angry emails. +ifeq ($(MAKELEVEL), 10) + $(error EMERGENCY ABORT: INFINITE RECURSION DETECTED) +endif + +# Need to special-case building without a per-project object directory +ifeq ($(OBJDIR),) + # If no target specified, force "clean all" and disallow parallel build + ifeq ($(MAKECMDGOALS),) + MAKECMDGOALS := clean all + .NOTPARALLEL: + endif + + # If one of the targets is to build, force "clean" beforehand and disallow parallel build + ifneq ($(findstring all, $(MAKECMDGOALS)),) + MAKECMDGOALS := clean $(MAKECMDGOALS) + .NOTPARALLEL: + endif +endif + +%: $(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES) + @echo . > /dev/null + +$(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES): + @$(MAKE) -C $@ $(MAKECMDGOALS) + +.PHONY: $(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES) diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/Board/Board.h b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/Board/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..33b65fe4cd --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/Board/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Custom Board Hardware Information Driver (Template) + * + * This is a stub driver header file, for implementing custom board + * layout hardware with compatible LUFA board specific drivers. If + * the library is configured to use the BOARD_USER board mode, this + * driver file should be completed and copied into the "/Board/" folder + * inside the application's folder. + * + * This stub is for the board-specific component of the LUFA Board Hardware + * information driver. + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_USER_H__ +#define __BOARD_USER_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + // TODO: Add any required includes here + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Buttons mounted if defined. */ +// #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Dataflash mounted if defined. */ +// #define BOARD_HAS_DATAFLASH + + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Joystick mounted if defined. */ +// #define BOARD_HAS_JOYSTICK + + /** Indicates the board has a hardware LEDs mounted if defined. */ +// #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/Board/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/Board/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c1a23ef087 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/Board/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,92 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Custom Board Button Hardware Driver (Template) + * + * This is a stub driver header file, for implementing custom board + * layout hardware with compatible LUFA board specific drivers. If + * the library is configured to use the BOARD_USER board mode, this + * driver file should be completed and copied into the "/Board/" folder + * inside the application's folder. + * + * This stub is for the board-specific component of the LUFA Buttons driver, + * for the control of physical board-mounted GPIO pushbuttons. + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_USER_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_USER_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + // TODO: Add any required includes here + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + #define BOARD_DUMMY_BUTTONS_IMPLEMENTATION + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 0) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return 0; + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/Board/Dataflash.h b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/Board/Dataflash.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..86726a2923 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/Board/Dataflash.h @@ -0,0 +1,197 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Custom Board Dataflash Hardware Driver (Template) + * + * This is a stub driver header file, for implementing custom board + * layout hardware with compatible LUFA board specific drivers. If + * the library is configured to use the BOARD_USER board mode, this + * driver file should be completed and copied into the "/Board/" folder + * inside the application's folder. + * + * This stub is for the board-specific component of the LUFA Dataflash + * driver. +*/ + +#ifndef __DATAFLASH_USER_H__ +#define __DATAFLASH_USER_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + // TODO: Add any required includes here + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_DATAFLASH_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h instead. + #endif + + #define BOARD_DUMMY_DATAFLASH_IMPLEMENTATION + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK 0 + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_DDR 0 + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT 0 + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Constant indicating the total number of dataflash ICs mounted on the selected board. */ + #define DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS 1 + + /** Mask for no dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP 0 + + /** Mask for the first dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIP1 0 + + /** Mask for the second dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIP2 0 + + /** Internal main memory page size for the board's dataflash ICs. */ + #define DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE 0 + + /** Total number of pages inside each of the board's dataflash ICs. */ + #define DATAFLASH_PAGES 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initializes the dataflash driver so that commands and data may be sent to an attached dataflash IC. + * The microcontroller's SPI driver MUST be initialized before any of the dataflash commands are used. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_Init(void) + { + + } + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns a byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + return 0; + } + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and ignores the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + + } + + /** Sends a dummy byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) + { + return 0; + } + + /** Determines the currently selected dataflash chip. + * + * \return Mask of the currently selected Dataflash chip, either \ref DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP if no chip is selected + * or a DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is the chip number). + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) + { + return 0; + } + + /** Selects the given dataflash chip. + * + * \param[in] ChipMask Mask of the Dataflash IC to select, in the form of a \c DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is + * the chip number). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) + { + + } + + /** Deselects the current dataflash chip, so that no dataflash is selected. */ + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) + { + + } + + /** Selects a dataflash IC from the given page number, which should range from 0 to + * ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). For boards containing only one + * dataflash IC, this will select DATAFLASH_CHIP1. If the given page number is outside + * the total number of pages contained in the boards dataflash ICs, all dataflash ICs + * are deselected. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Address of the page to manipulate, ranging from + * 0 to ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(const uint16_t PageAddress) + { + + } + + /** Toggles the select line of the currently selected dataflash IC, so that it is ready to receive + * a new command. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(void) + { + + } + + /** Spin-loops while the currently selected dataflash is busy executing a command, such as a main + * memory page program or main memory to buffer transfer. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(void) + { + + } + + /** Sends a set of page and buffer address bytes to the currently selected dataflash IC, for use with + * dataflash commands which require a complete 24-bit address. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Page address within the selected dataflash IC + * \param[in] BufferByte Address within the dataflash's buffer + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(uint16_t PageAddress, const uint16_t BufferByte) + { + + } + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/Board/Joystick.h b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/Board/Joystick.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..86a7d7681d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/Board/Joystick.h @@ -0,0 +1,104 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Custom Board Joystick Hardware Driver (Template) + * + * This is a stub driver header file, for implementing custom board + * layout hardware with compatible LUFA board specific drivers. If + * the library is configured to use the BOARD_USER board mode, this + * driver file should be completed and copied into the "/Board/" folder + * inside the application's folder. + * + * This stub is for the board-specific component of the LUFA Joystick + * driver, for a digital four-way (plus button) joystick. +*/ + +#ifndef __JOYSTICK_USER_H__ +#define __JOYSTICK_USER_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + // TODO: Add any required includes here + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_JOYSTICK_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h instead. + #endif + + #define BOARD_DUMMY_JOYSTICK_IMPLEMENTATION + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the left direction. */ + #define JOY_LEFT 0 + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the right direction. */ + #define JOY_RIGHT 0 + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the upward direction. */ + #define JOY_UP 0 + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the downward direction. */ + #define JOY_DOWN 0 + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed inward. */ + #define JOY_PRESS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Joystick_Init(void) + { + + } + + static inline void Joystick_Disable(void) + { + + } + + static inline uint8_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) + { + return 0; + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/Board/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/Board/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..548d24232c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/Board/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,132 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Custom Board LED Hardware Driver (Template) + * + * This is a stub driver header file, for implementing custom board + * layout hardware with compatible LUFA board specific drivers. If + * the library is configured to use the BOARD_USER board mode, this + * driver file should be completed and copied into the "/Board/" folder + * inside the application's folder. + * + * This stub is for the board-specific component of the LUFA LEDs driver, + * for the LEDs (up to four) mounted on most development boards. +*/ + +#ifndef __LEDS_USER_H__ +#define __LEDS_USER_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + // TODO: Add any required includes here + +/* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + #define BOARD_DUMMY_LEDS_IMPLEMENTATION + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 0) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 1) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 2) + + /** LED mask for the fourth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED4 (1 << 3) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return 0; + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/BoardDeviceMap.cfg b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/BoardDeviceMap.cfg new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c12050941d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/BoardDeviceMap.cfg @@ -0,0 +1,89 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# +# ============================================================================= +# Board configuration map script, processed with the "BoardDriverTest" +# makefile. This script file maps the possible LUFA target BOARD makefile +# values in user projects to a specific architecture and device. This mapping is +# then used by the makefile to build all possible drivers for that board, to +# detect any missing or erroneous functions. To add a new board mapping, use +# the syntax: +# +# BOARD DEFINE = {ARCH} : {MCU} : +# +# And re-run the makefile. Note that each board may have only one target. +# ============================================================================= +# +# +# ----------------- AVR8 Boards ------------------ +BOARD_ADAFRUITU4 = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : +BOARD_ATAVRUSBRF01 = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : +BOARD_BENITO = AVR8 : at90usb162 : +BOARD_BIGMULTIO = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : +BOARD_BLACKCAT = AVR8 : at90usb162 : +BOARD_BUI = AVR8 : at90usb646 : +BOARD_BUMBLEB = AVR8 : at90usb162 : +BOARD_CULV3 = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : +BOARD_DUCE = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : +BOARD_EVK527 = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : +BOARD_JMDBU2 = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : +BOARD_LEONARDO = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : +BOARD_MAXIMUS = AVR8 : at90usb162 : +BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : +BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_A = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : +BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_1 = AVR8 : at90usb162 : +BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_2 = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : +BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_3 = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : +BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_4 = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : +BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_DIP = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : +BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV1 = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : +BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV2 = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : +BOARD_MICROSIN162 = AVR8 : atmega162 : +BOARD_MINIMUS = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : +BOARD_MULTIO = AVR8 : at90usb162 : +BOARD_NONE = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : +BOARD_OLIMEX162 = AVR8 : at90usb162 : +BOARD_OLIMEX32U4 = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : +BOARD_OLIMEXT32U4 = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : +BOARD_OLIMEXISPMK2 = AVR8 : at90usb162 : +BOARD_RZUSBSTICK = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : +BOARD_SPARKFUN8U2 = AVR8 : atmega8u2 : +BOARD_STK525 = AVR8 : at90usb647 : +BOARD_STK526 = AVR8 : at90usb162 : +BOARD_TEENSY = AVR8 : at90usb162 : +BOARD_TEENSY2 = AVR8 : at90usb646 : +BOARD_TUL = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : +BOARD_UDIP = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : +BOARD_UNO = AVR8 : atmega8u2 : +BOARD_USB2AX = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : +BOARD_USB2AX_V3 = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : +BOARD_USB2AX_V31 = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : +BOARD_USBFOO = AVR8 : atmega162 : +BOARD_USBKEY = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : +BOARD_USBTINYMKII = AVR8 : at90usb162 : +BOARD_USER = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : +BOARD_XPLAIN = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : +BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1 = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : +BOARD_STANGE_ISP = AVR8 : at90usb162 : +BOARD_U2S = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : +BOARD_YUN = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : +BOARD_MICRO = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : +BOARD_POLOLUMICRO = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : +BOARD_XPLAINED_MINI = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : +# +# ----------------- XMEGA Boards ----------------- +BOARD_A3BU_XPLAINED = XMEGA : atxmega256a3bu : +BOARD_B1_XPLAINED = XMEGA : atxmega128b1 : +BOARD_C3_XPLAINED = XMEGA : atxmega384c3 : +# +# ------------------ UC3 Boards ------------------ +BOARD_EVK1100 = UC3 : uc3a0512 : +BOARD_EVK1101 = UC3 : uc3b0256 : +BOARD_EVK1104 = UC3 : uc3a3256 : +BOARD_UC3A3_XPLAINED = UC3 : uc3a3256 : +# diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/Test.c b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/Test.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8baa4460ba --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/Test.c @@ -0,0 +1,115 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> +#include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h> +#include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> +#include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h> +#include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> +#include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + +#if defined(BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS) == defined(BOARD_DUMMY_BUTTONS_IMPLEMENTATION) + #error Mismatch between BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS and implementation. +#endif + +#if defined(BOARD_HAS_DATAFLASH) == defined(BOARD_DUMMY_DATAFLASH_IMPLEMENTATION) + #error Mismatch between BOARD_HAS_DATAFLASH and implementation. +#endif + +#if defined(BOARD_HAS_LEDS) == defined(BOARD_DUMMY_LEDS_IMPLEMENTATION) + #error Mismatch between BOARD_HAS_LEDS and implementation. +#endif + +#if defined(BOARD_HAS_JOYSTICK) == defined(BOARD_DUMMY_JOYSTICK_IMPLEMENTATION) + #error Mismatch between BOARD_HAS_JOYSTICK and implementation. +#endif + +int main(void) +{ + uint_reg_t Dummy; + + /* ============================= + * Buttons Compile Check + * ============================= */ + // cppcheck-suppress redundantAssignment + Dummy = BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + Buttons_Init(); + // cppcheck-suppress redundantAssignment + Dummy = Buttons_GetStatus(); + Buttons_Disable(); + + /* ============================= + * Dataflash Compile Check + * ============================= */ + // cppcheck-suppress redundantAssignment + Dummy = DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS + DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP + DATAFLASH_CHIP1 + DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE + DATAFLASH_PAGES; + Dataflash_Init(); + Dataflash_TransferByte(0); + Dataflash_SendByte(0); + // cppcheck-suppress redundantAssignment + Dummy = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + // cppcheck-suppress redundantAssignment + Dummy = Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(); + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(0); + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, 0); + + /* ============================= + * LEDs Compile Check + * ============================= */ + // cppcheck-suppress redundantAssignment + Dummy = LEDS_LED1 + LEDS_LED2 + LEDS_LED3 + LEDS_LED4; + LEDs_Init(); + LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + LEDs_ChangeLEDs(LEDS_ALL_LEDS, LEDS_NO_LEDS); + LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + // cppcheck-suppress redundantAssignment + Dummy = LEDs_GetLEDs(); + LEDs_Disable(); + + /* ============================= + * Joystick Compile Check + * ============================= */ + // cppcheck-suppress redundantAssignment + Dummy = JOY_LEFT + JOY_RIGHT + JOY_UP + JOY_DOWN + JOY_PRESS; + Joystick_Init(); + // cppcheck-suppress redundantAssignment + Dummy = Joystick_GetStatus(); + Joystick_Disable(); + + (void)Dummy; +} + + diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/makefile b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8414d91862 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,69 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +# Makefile for the board driver build test. This +# test attempts to build a dummy project with all +# possible board targets using their respective +# compiler. + +# Path to the LUFA library core +LUFA_PATH := ../../LUFA/ + +# Build test cannot be run with multiple parallel jobs +.NOTPARALLEL: + +all: begin makeboardlist testboards clean end + +begin: + @echo Executing build test "BoardDriverTest". + @echo + +end: + @echo Build test "BoardDriverTest" complete. + @echo + +makeboardlist: + @grep "BOARD_" $(patsubst %/,%,$(LUFA_PATH))/Common/BoardTypes.h | cut -d'#' -f2 | cut -d' ' -f2 | grep "BOARD_" > BoardList.txt + +testboards: + @echo "buildtest:" > BuildMakefile + + @while read line; \ + do \ + build_cfg=`grep "$$line " BoardDeviceMap.cfg | grep -v "#" | cut -d'=' -f2- | sed 's/ //g'`; \ + \ + build_board=$$line; \ + build_arch=`echo $$build_cfg | cut -d':' -f1`; \ + build_mcu=`echo $$build_cfg | cut -d':' -f2`; \ + \ + if ( test -z "$$build_cfg" ); then \ + echo "No matching information set for board $$build_board"; \ + else \ + echo "Found board configuration for $$build_board - $$build_arch, $$build_mcu"; \ + \ + printf "\t@echo Building dummy project for $$build_board...\n" >> BuildMakefile; \ + printf "\t$(MAKE) -f makefile.test clean elf MCU=%s ARCH=%s BOARD=%s\n\n" $$build_mcu $$build_arch $$build_board >> BuildMakefile; \ + fi; \ + done < BoardList.txt + + $(MAKE) -f BuildMakefile buildtest + +clean: + rm -f BuildMakefile + rm -f BoardList.txt + $(MAKE) -f makefile.test clean BOARD=NONE ARCH=AVR8 MCU=at90usb1287 + $(MAKE) -f makefile.test clean BOARD=NONE ARCH=XMEGA MCU=atxmega128a1u + $(MAKE) -f makefile.test clean BOARD=NONE ARCH=UC3 MCU=uc3a0256 + +%: + +.PHONY: all begin end makeboardlist testboards clean + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/makefile.test b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/makefile.test new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..373a15e753 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BoardDriverTest/makefile.test @@ -0,0 +1,35 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = +ARCH = +BOARD = +F_CPU = $(F_USB) +F_USB = 8000000 +OPTIMIZATION = 1 +TARGET = Test +SRC = $(TARGET).c +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -Werror +DEBUG_LEVEL = 0 + + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BootloaderTest/BootloaderDeviceMap.cfg b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BootloaderTest/BootloaderDeviceMap.cfg new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e02d0a30d4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BootloaderTest/BootloaderDeviceMap.cfg @@ -0,0 +1,167 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# +# ============================================================================= +# Bootloader configuration map script, processed with the "BootloaderTest" +# makefile. This script file defines the targets for each LUFA bootloader, +# which are then built as part of the build test to ensure that there are no +# failures on all standard configurations. To add a new build target for a +# bootloader to this script, use the format: +# +# BOOTLOADER = {ARCH} : {MCU} : {BOARD} : {FLASH SIZE KB} : {BOOT SIZE KB} : {F_USB MHZ} +# +# And re-run the makefile. +# ============================================================================= +# +# +# ------------ CDC Bootloader -------------------- +CDC = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : XPLAIN : 128 : 8 : 8 : +CDC = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 8 : +CDC = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 8 : +CDC = AVR8 : at90usb647 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 8 : +CDC = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 8 : +CDC = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 8 : +CDC = AVR8 : at90usb646 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 8 : +CDC = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 8 : +CDC = AVR8 : atmega16u4 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 8 : +CDC = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 8 : +CDC = AVR8 : atmega16u2 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 8 : +CDC = AVR8 : atmega8u2 : NONE : 8 : 4 : 8 : +CDC = AVR8 : at90usb162 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 8 : +CDC = AVR8 : at90usb82 : NONE : 8 : 4 : 8 : +CDC = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 16 : +CDC = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 16 : +CDC = AVR8 : at90usb647 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 16 : +CDC = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 16 : +CDC = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 16 : +CDC = AVR8 : at90usb646 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 16 : +CDC = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 16 : +CDC = AVR8 : atmega16u4 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 16 : +CDC = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 16 : +CDC = AVR8 : atmega16u2 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 16 : +CDC = AVR8 : atmega8u2 : NONE : 8 : 4 : 16 : +CDC = AVR8 : at90usb162 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 16 : +CDC = AVR8 : at90usb82 : NONE : 8 : 4 : 16 : +# +# ------------ DFU Bootloader -------------------- +DFU = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : XPLAIN : 128 : 8 : 8 : +DFU = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 8 : +DFU = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 8 : +DFU = AVR8 : at90usb647 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 8 : +DFU = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 8 : +DFU = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 8 : +DFU = AVR8 : at90usb646 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 8 : +DFU = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 8 : +DFU = AVR8 : atmega16u4 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 8 : +DFU = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 8 : +DFU = AVR8 : atmega16u2 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 8 : +DFU = AVR8 : atmega8u2 : NONE : 8 : 4 : 8 : +DFU = AVR8 : at90usb162 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 8 : +DFU = AVR8 : at90usb82 : NONE : 8 : 4 : 8 : +DFU = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 16 : +DFU = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 16 : +DFU = AVR8 : at90usb647 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 16 : +DFU = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 16 : +DFU = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 16 : +DFU = AVR8 : at90usb646 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 16 : +DFU = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 16 : +DFU = AVR8 : atmega16u4 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 16 : +DFU = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 16 : +DFU = AVR8 : atmega16u2 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 16 : +DFU = AVR8 : atmega8u2 : NONE : 8 : 4 : 16 : +DFU = AVR8 : at90usb162 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 16 : +DFU = AVR8 : at90usb82 : NONE : 8 : 4 : 16 : +# +# ------------ HID Bootloader -------------------- +HID = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : at90usb647 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : at90usb646 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : atmega16u4 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : NONE : 32 : 2 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : atmega16u2 : NONE : 16 : 2 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : atmega16u2 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : atmega8u2 : NONE : 8 : 2 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : atmega8u2 : NONE : 8 : 4 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : at90usb162 : NONE : 16 : 2 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : at90usb162 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : at90usb162 : NONE : 16 : 2 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : at90usb162 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : at90usb647 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 8 : +HID = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 16 : +HID = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 16 : +HID = AVR8 : at90usb646 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 16 : +HID = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 16 : +HID = AVR8 : atmega16u4 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 16 : +HID = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : NONE : 32 : 2 : 16 : +HID = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 16 : +HID = AVR8 : atmega16u2 : NONE : 16 : 2 : 16 : +HID = AVR8 : atmega16u2 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 16 : +HID = AVR8 : atmega8u2 : NONE : 8 : 2 : 16 : +HID = AVR8 : atmega8u2 : NONE : 8 : 4 : 16 : +HID = AVR8 : at90usb162 : NONE : 16 : 2 : 16 : +HID = AVR8 : at90usb162 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 16 : +HID = AVR8 : at90usb162 : NONE : 16 : 2 : 16 : +HID = AVR8 : at90usb162 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 16 : +# +# ---------- Printer Bootloader ------------------ +Printer = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 8 : +Printer = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 8 : +Printer = AVR8 : at90usb647 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 8 : +Printer = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 8 : +Printer = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 8 : +Printer = AVR8 : at90usb646 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 8 : +Printer = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 8 : +Printer = AVR8 : atmega16u4 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 8 : +Printer = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 8 : +Printer = AVR8 : atmega16u2 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 8 : +Printer = AVR8 : atmega8u2 : NONE : 8 : 4 : 8 : +Printer = AVR8 : at90usb162 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 8 : +Printer = AVR8 : at90usb82 : NONE : 8 : 4 : 8 : +Printer = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 16 : +Printer = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 16 : +Printer = AVR8 : at90usb647 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 16 : +Printer = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 16 : +Printer = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 16 : +Printer = AVR8 : at90usb646 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 16 : +Printer = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 16 : +Printer = AVR8 : atmega16u4 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 16 : +Printer = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 16 : +Printer = AVR8 : atmega16u2 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 16 : +Printer = AVR8 : atmega8u2 : NONE : 8 : 4 : 16 : +Printer = AVR8 : at90usb162 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 16 : +Printer = AVR8 : at90usb82 : NONE : 8 : 4 : 16 : +# +# ---------- Mass Storage Bootloader ----------------- +MassStorage = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : XPLAIN : 128 : 8 : 8 : +MassStorage = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 8 : +MassStorage = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 8 : +MassStorage = AVR8 : at90usb647 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 8 : +MassStorage = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 8 : +MassStorage = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 8 : +MassStorage = AVR8 : at90usb646 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 8 : +MassStorage = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : LEONARDO : 32 : 4 : 16 : +MassStorage = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 8 : +MassStorage = AVR8 : atmega16u4 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 8 : +MassStorage = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 8 : +MassStorage = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 16 : +MassStorage = AVR8 : at90usb1287 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 16 : +MassStorage = AVR8 : at90usb647 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 16 : +MassStorage = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 8 : 16 : +MassStorage = AVR8 : at90usb1286 : NONE : 128 : 4 : 16 : +MassStorage = AVR8 : at90usb646 : NONE : 64 : 4 : 16 : +MassStorage = AVR8 : atmega32u4 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 16 : +MassStorage = AVR8 : atmega16u4 : NONE : 16 : 4 : 16 : +MassStorage = AVR8 : atmega32u2 : NONE : 32 : 4 : 16 : +# diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BootloaderTest/makefile b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BootloaderTest/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..34bdf1b364 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/BootloaderTest/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,65 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +# Makefile for the bootloader build test. This +# test attempts to build all the bootloaders +# with all supported device configurations. + +# Path to the LUFA library core +LUFA_PATH := ../../LUFA/ + +# Build test cannot be run with multiple parallel jobs +.NOTPARALLEL: + +all: begin testbootloaders clean end + +begin: + @echo Executing build test "BootloaderTest". + @echo + +end: + @echo Build test "BootloaderTest" complete. + @echo + +testbootloaders: + @echo "buildtest:" > BuildMakefile + + @while read line; \ + do \ + build_cfg=`echo $$line | grep -v "#" | sed 's/ //g'`; \ + \ + if ( test -n "$$build_cfg" ); then \ + build_bootloader=`echo $$build_cfg | cut -d'=' -f1`; \ + build_cfg=`echo $$build_cfg | cut -d'=' -f2-`; \ + \ + build_arch=`echo $$build_cfg | cut -d':' -f1`; \ + build_mcu=`echo $$build_cfg | cut -d':' -f2`; \ + build_board=`echo $$build_cfg | cut -d':' -f3`; \ + build_flashsize=`echo $$build_cfg | cut -d':' -f4`; \ + build_bootsize=`echo $$build_cfg | cut -d':' -f5`; \ + build_fusb=`echo $$build_cfg | cut -d':' -f6`; \ + \ + printf "Found '%s' bootloader configuration (FLASH: %3s KB | BOOT: %3s KB | MCU: %12s / %4s | BOARD: %s | F_USB: %sMHz)\n" $$build_bootloader $$build_flashsize $$build_bootsize $$build_mcu $$build_arch $$build_board $$build_fusb; \ + \ + printf "\t@echo Building bootloader %s - %s - FLASH: %s KB, BOOT: %s KB, BOARD: %s, F_USB: %sMHz\n" $$build_bootloader $$build_mcu $$build_flashsize $$build_bootsize $$build_board $$build_fusb >> BuildMakefile; \ + printf "\t$(MAKE) -C $(patsubst %/,%,$(LUFA_PATH))/../Bootloaders/%s/ clean elf ARCH=%s MCU=%s BOARD=%s FLASH_SIZE_KB=%s BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB=%s F_USB=%s000000 DEBUG_LEVEL=0\n\n" $$build_bootloader $$build_arch $$build_mcu $$build_board $$build_flashsize $$build_bootsize $$build_fusb >> BuildMakefile; \ + fi; \ + done < BootloaderDeviceMap.cfg + + $(MAKE) -f BuildMakefile buildtest + +clean: + rm -f BuildMakefile + +%: + +.PHONY: all begin end testbootloaders clean + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/ModuleTest/Dummy.S b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/ModuleTest/Dummy.S new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b44cf4c256 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/ModuleTest/Dummy.S @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +.section .text + + +# Mandatory entry point for successful compilation and link +.global main +main: + + +# Mandatory callback needed for base compile of the USB driver +.global CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor +CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor: diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/ModuleTest/Modules.h b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/ModuleTest/Modules.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..686183245d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/ModuleTest/Modules.h @@ -0,0 +1,56 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + +#include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + +#include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> +#include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/RingBuffer.h> +#include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + #if defined(ADC) + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/ADC.h> + #endif + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SerialSPI.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SPI.h> + + #if defined(TWCR) + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/TWI.h> + #endif +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SerialSPI.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SPI.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/TWI.h> +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/ModuleTest/Test_C.c b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/ModuleTest/Test_C.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3c3f5a2ab7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/ModuleTest/Test_C.c @@ -0,0 +1,31 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "Modules.h" diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/ModuleTest/Test_CPP.cpp b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/ModuleTest/Test_CPP.cpp new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3c3f5a2ab7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/ModuleTest/Test_CPP.cpp @@ -0,0 +1,31 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "Modules.h" diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/ModuleTest/makefile b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/ModuleTest/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..50f1909a38 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/ModuleTest/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,67 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +# Makefile for the module build test. This test +# attempts to build as many modules as possible +# under all supported architectures, and include +# all module headers in a simple C and C++ +# application. + +# Path to the LUFA library core +LUFA_PATH := ../../LUFA/ + +# Build test cannot be run with multiple parallel jobs +.NOTPARALLEL: + +# List of device families per architecture, one device per architecture sub-family +AVR8_FAMILIES := at90usb1287 at90usb1286 atmega16u4 atmega16u2 at90usb162 +XMEGA_FAMILIES := atxmega128a1u atxmega128a3u atxmega256a3bu atxmega128a4u atxmega128b1 atxmega128b3 atxmega128c3 atxmega32c4 +UC3_FAMILIES := uc3a0256 uc3a1256 uc3a3256 uc3a4256 uc3b0256 uc3b1256 + +# List of all device families, with a family postfix +DEVICE_FAMILIES := $(AVR8_FAMILIES:%=%.avr8) $(XMEGA_FAMILIES:%=%.xmega) $(UC3_FAMILIES:%=%.uc3) + + +all: begin $(DEVICE_FAMILIES) clean end + +arch_avr8: begin $(AVR8_FAMILIES:%=%.avr8) end +arch_xmega: begin $(XMEGA_FAMILIES:%=%.xmega) end +arch_uc3: begin $(UC3_FAMILIES:%=%.uc3) end + +begin: + @echo Executing build test "ModuleTest". + @echo + +end: + @echo Build test "ModuleTest" complete. + @echo + +%.avr8: + @echo Building ModuleTest for ARCH=AVR8 MCU=$(@:%.avr8=%)... + $(MAKE) -f makefile.test clean elf ARCH=AVR8 MCU=$(@:%.avr8=%) + +%.xmega: + @echo Building ModuleTest for ARCH=XMEGA MCU=$(@:%.xmega=%)... + $(MAKE) -f makefile.test clean elf ARCH=XMEGA MCU=$(@:%.xmega=%) + +%.uc3: + @echo Building ModuleTest for ARCH=UC3 MCU=$(@:%.uc3=%)... + $(MAKE) -f makefile.test clean elf ARCH=UC3 MCU=$(@:%.uc3=%) + +clean: + $(MAKE) -f makefile.test clean ARCH=AVR8 MCU=$(firstword $(AVR8_FAMILIES)) + $(MAKE) -f makefile.test clean ARCH=XMEGA MCU=$(firstword $(XMEGA_FAMILIES)) + $(MAKE) -f makefile.test clean ARCH=UC3 MCU=$(firstword $(UC3_FAMILIES)) + +%: + +.PHONY: all arch_avr8 arch_xmega arch_uc3 begin end + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/ModuleTest/makefile.test b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/ModuleTest/makefile.test new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5eeb40398c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/ModuleTest/makefile.test @@ -0,0 +1,94 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = +ARCH = +BOARD = NONE +F_CPU = $(F_USB) +OPTIMIZATION = 1 +TARGET = Test +SRC = $(TARGET)_C.c $(TARGET)_CPP.cpp Dummy.S $(LUFA_SRC_USB) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +DEBUG_LEVEL = 0 + +ifeq ($(ARCH), AVR8) + F_USB = 8000000 +else ifeq ($(ARCH), XMEGA) + F_USB = 48000000 +else ifeq ($(ARCH), UC3) + F_USB = 48000000 +endif + +# Generic C/C++ compiler flags +CC_FLAGS = -Wextra +CC_FLAGS += -Werror +CC_FLAGS += -Wformat=2 +CC_FLAGS += -Winit-self +CC_FLAGS += -Wswitch-enum +CC_FLAGS += -Wunused +CC_FLAGS += -Wundef +CC_FLAGS += -Wpointer-arith +CC_FLAGS += -Wcast-align +CC_FLAGS += -Wwrite-strings +CC_FLAGS += -Wlogical-op +CC_FLAGS += -Wmissing-declarations +CC_FLAGS += -Wmissing-field-initializers +CC_FLAGS += -Wmissing-format-attribute +CC_FLAGS += -Woverlength-strings +CC_FLAGS += -Wswitch-default +CC_FLAGS += -Wfloat-equal +CC_FLAGS += -Waggregate-return +CC_FLAGS += -Wmissing-include-dirs + +# Disable warnings not supported by the version of GCC used for UC3 targets (FIXME) +ifneq ($(ARCH), UC3) + CC_FLAGS += -Wdouble-promotion +endif + +# Only enable redundant declaration warnings for AVR8 target (FIXME) +ifeq ($(ARCH), AVR8) + CC_FLAGS += -Wredundant-decls +endif + +# C compiler only flags +C_FLAGS += -Wmissing-parameter-type +C_FLAGS += -Wmissing-prototypes +C_FLAGS += -Wnested-externs +C_FLAGS += -Wbad-function-cast +C_FLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes +C_FLAGS += -Wold-style-definition + +# Disable warnings not supported by the version of GCC used for UC3 targets (FIXME) +ifneq ($(ARCH), UC3) + C_FLAGS += -Wunsuffixed-float-constants + C_FLAGS += -Wjump-misses-init +endif + +# Only check C++ compatibility on the build files, to ensure headers are C++ compatible +Test_C.c Test_CPP.cpp: CC_FLAGS += -Wc++-compat + +# Potential additional warnings to enable in the future (FIXME) +#CC_FLAGS += -Wcast-qual +#CC_FLAGS += -Wconversion +#CC_FLAGS += -Wsign-conversion +#CC_FLAGS += -pedantic + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/SingleUSBModeTest/Dummy.S b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/SingleUSBModeTest/Dummy.S new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1be4228d2d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/SingleUSBModeTest/Dummy.S @@ -0,0 +1,42 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +.section .text + + +# Mandatory entry point for successful compilation and link +.global main +main: + # Force code generation of the base USB stack + call USB_Init + +# Mandatory callback needed for base compile of the USB driver +.global CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor +CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor: diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/SingleUSBModeTest/Test.c b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/SingleUSBModeTest/Test.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7ac2e008f3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/SingleUSBModeTest/Test.c @@ -0,0 +1,32 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> +#include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/SingleUSBModeTest/makefile b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/SingleUSBModeTest/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7921ab6ca2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/SingleUSBModeTest/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,57 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +# Makefile for the single USB mode build test. +# This test attempts to build the USB module +# under fixed device and fixed host modes under +# all supported architectures + +# Path to the LUFA library core +LUFA_PATH := ../../LUFA/ + +# Build test cannot be run with multiple parallel jobs +.NOTPARALLEL: + +all: begin compile clean end + +begin: + @echo Executing build test "SingleUSBModeTest". + @echo + +end: + @echo Build test "SingleUSBModeTest" complete. + @echo + +compile: + @echo Building SingleUSBModeTest for ARCH=AVR8 in device only mode... + $(MAKE) -f makefile.test clean elf ARCH=AVR8 MCU=at90usb1287 CC_FLAGS='-D USB_DEVICE_ONLY' + + @echo Building SingleUSBModeTest for ARCH=AVR8 in host only mode... + $(MAKE) -f makefile.test clean elf ARCH=AVR8 MCU=at90usb1287 CC_FLAGS='-D USB_HOST_ONLY' + + @echo Building SingleUSBModeTest for ARCH=XMEGA in device only mode... + $(MAKE) -f makefile.test clean elf ARCH=XMEGA MCU=atxmega128a1u CC_FLAGS='-D USB_DEVICE_ONLY' + + @echo Building SingleUSBModeTest for ARCH=UC3 in device only mode... + $(MAKE) -f makefile.test clean elf ARCH=UC3 MCU=uc3a0256 CC_FLAGS='-D USB_DEVICE_ONLY' + + @echo Building SingleUSBModeTest for ARCH=UC3 in host only mode... + $(MAKE) -f makefile.test clean elf ARCH=UC3 MCU=uc3a0256 CC_FLAGS='-D USB_HOST_ONLY' + +clean: + $(MAKE) -f makefile.test clean ARCH=AVR8 MCU=at90usb1287 + $(MAKE) -f makefile.test clean ARCH=XMEGA MCU=atxmega128a1u + $(MAKE) -f makefile.test clean ARCH=UC3 MCU=uc3a0256 + +%: + +.PHONY: begin end compile clean + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/SingleUSBModeTest/makefile.test b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/SingleUSBModeTest/makefile.test new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..365c7d00b5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/SingleUSBModeTest/makefile.test @@ -0,0 +1,75 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = +ARCH = +BOARD = NONE +F_CPU = $(F_USB) +DEBUG_LEVEL = 0 + +ifeq ($(ARCH), AVR8) + F_USB = 8000000 +else ifeq ($(ARCH), XMEGA) + F_USB = 48000000 +else ifeq ($(ARCH), UC3) + F_USB = 48000000 +endif + +OPTIMIZATION = 1 +TARGET = Test +SRC = Test.c Dummy.S $(LUFA_SRC_USB) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA + +# Generic C/C++ compiler flags +CC_FLAGS = -Wextra +CC_FLAGS += -Werror +CC_FLAGS += -Wformat=2 +CC_FLAGS += -Winit-self +CC_FLAGS += -Wswitch-enum +CC_FLAGS += -Wunused +CC_FLAGS += -Wundef +CC_FLAGS += -Wpointer-arith +CC_FLAGS += -Wcast-align +CC_FLAGS += -Wwrite-strings +CC_FLAGS += -Wlogical-op +CC_FLAGS += -Wmissing-declarations +CC_FLAGS += -Wmissing-field-initializers +CC_FLAGS += -Wmissing-format-attribute +CC_FLAGS += -Woverlength-strings + +# Only enable rendundant declaration warnings for AVR8 target (FIXME) +ifeq ($(ARCH), AVR8) + CC_FLAGS += -Wredundant-decls +endif + +# C compiler only flags +C_FLAGS += -Wmissing-parameter-type +C_FLAGS += -Wnested-externs + +# Potential additional warnings to enable in the future (FIXME) +#CC_FLAGS += -Wswitch-default +#CC_FLAGS += -Wc++-compat +#CC_FLAGS += -Wcast-qual +#CC_FLAGS += -Wconversion +#CC_FLAGS += -Wjump-misses-init +#CC_FLAGS += -pedantic + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/StaticAnalysisTest/makefile b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/StaticAnalysisTest/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0041234d19 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/StaticAnalysisTest/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,47 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +# Static anlysis of the entire LUFA source tree, using the free cross-platform "cppcheck" tool. + +# Path to the LUFA library core +LUFA_PATH := ../../LUFA/ + +CPPCHECK_EXCLUDES := FATFs/ \ + PetiteFATFs/ \ + uip/ + +CPPCHECK_INCLUDES := $(patsubst %/,%,$(LUFA_PATH))/CodeTemplates/ \ + $(patsubst %/,%,$(LUFA_PATH))/../Projects/AVRISP-MKII/ + +CPPCHECK_FLAGS := -U TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME -U __GNUC__ -U __DOXYGEN__ + +CPPCHECK_SUPPRESS := variableScope missingInclude unusedFunction + +SRC := $(patsubst %/,%,$(LUFA_PATH))/.. + +# Build test cannot be run with multiple parallel jobs +.NOTPARALLEL: + +all: begin cppcheck end + +begin: + @echo Executing build test "StaticAnalysisTest". + @echo + +end: + @echo Build test "StaticAnalysisTest" complete. + @echo + +%: + +.PHONY: all begin end + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/BuildTests/makefile b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..369ea9ad29 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/BuildTests/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,24 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +# Makefile to build all the LUFA Build Tests. Build Tests are +# used to verify the correctness of the LUFA library, and are +# not intended to be modified or compiled by non-developers. + +all: + +%: + @echo Executing \"make $@\" on all LUFA build tests. + @echo + $(MAKE) -C BoardDriverTest $@ + $(MAKE) -C BootloaderTest $@ + $(MAKE) -C ModuleTest $@ + $(MAKE) -C SingleUSBModeTest $@ + $(MAKE) -C StaticAnalysisTest $@ + @echo + @echo LUFA build test \"make $@\" operation complete. diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/AudioInput.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/AudioInput.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2870bcd6f7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/AudioInput.c @@ -0,0 +1,274 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the AudioInput demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "AudioInput.h" + +/** LUFA Audio Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all Audio Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t Microphone_Audio_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .ControlInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioControl, + .StreamingInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = AUDIO_STREAM_EPADDR, + .Size = AUDIO_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 2, + }, + }, + }; + +/** Current audio sampling frequency of the streaming audio endpoint. */ +static uint32_t CurrentAudioSampleFrequency = 48000; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + Audio_Device_USBTask(&Microphone_Audio_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + Buttons_Init(); + ADC_Init(ADC_FREE_RUNNING | ADC_PRESCALE_32); + ADC_SetupChannel(MIC_IN_ADC_CHANNEL); + USB_Init(); + + /* Start the ADC conversion in free running mode */ + ADC_StartReading(ADC_REFERENCE_AVCC | ADC_RIGHT_ADJUSTED | ADC_GET_CHANNEL_MASK(MIC_IN_ADC_CHANNEL)); +} + +/** ISR to handle the reloading of the data endpoint with the next sample. */ +ISR(TIMER0_COMPA_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + uint8_t PrevEndpoint = Endpoint_GetCurrentEndpoint(); + + /* Check that the USB bus is ready for the next sample to write */ + if (Audio_Device_IsReadyForNextSample(&Microphone_Audio_Interface)) + { + int16_t AudioSample; + + #if defined(USE_TEST_TONE) + static uint8_t SquareWaveSampleCount; + static int16_t CurrentWaveValue; + + /* In test tone mode, generate a square wave at 1/256 of the sample rate */ + if (SquareWaveSampleCount++ == 0xFF) + CurrentWaveValue ^= 0x8000; + + /* Only generate audio if the board button is being pressed */ + AudioSample = (Buttons_GetStatus() & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ? CurrentWaveValue : 0; + #else + /* Audio sample is ADC value scaled to fit the entire range */ + AudioSample = ((SAMPLE_MAX_RANGE / ADC_MAX_RANGE) * ADC_GetResult()); + + #if defined(MICROPHONE_BIASED_TO_HALF_RAIL) + /* Microphone is biased to half rail voltage, subtract the bias from the sample value */ + AudioSample -= (SAMPLE_MAX_RANGE / 2); + #endif + #endif + + Audio_Device_WriteSample16(&Microphone_Audio_Interface, AudioSample); + } + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(PrevEndpoint); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + /* Sample reload timer initialization */ + TIMSK0 = (1 << OCIE0A); + OCR0A = ((F_CPU / 8 / CurrentAudioSampleFrequency) - 1); + TCCR0A = (1 << WGM01); // CTC mode + TCCR0B = (1 << CS01); // Fcpu/8 speed +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + /* Stop the sample reload timer */ + TCCR0B = 0; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= Audio_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Microphone_Audio_Interface); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + Audio_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Microphone_Audio_Interface); +} + +/** Audio class driver callback for the setting and retrieval of streaming endpoint properties. This callback must be implemented + * in the user application to handle property manipulations on streaming audio endpoints. + * + * When the DataLength parameter is NULL, this callback should only indicate whether the specified operation is valid for + * the given endpoint index, and should return as fast as possible. When non-NULL, this value may be altered for GET operations + * to indicate the size of the retrieved data. + * + * \note The length of the retrieved data stored into the Data buffer on GET operations should not exceed the initial value + * of the \c DataLength parameter. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] EndpointProperty Property of the endpoint to get or set, a value from Audio_ClassRequests_t. + * \param[in] EndpointAddress Address of the streaming endpoint whose property is being referenced. + * \param[in] EndpointControl Parameter of the endpoint to get or set, a value from Audio_EndpointControls_t. + * \param[in,out] DataLength For SET operations, the length of the parameter data to set. For GET operations, the maximum + * length of the retrieved data. When NULL, the function should return whether the given property + * and parameter is valid for the requested endpoint without reading or modifying the Data buffer. + * \param[in,out] Data Pointer to a location where the parameter data is stored for SET operations, or where + * the retrieved data is to be stored for GET operations. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the property get/set was successful, \c false otherwise + */ +bool CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetEndpointProperty(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t EndpointProperty, + const uint8_t EndpointAddress, + const uint8_t EndpointControl, + uint16_t* const DataLength, + uint8_t* Data) +{ + /* Check the requested endpoint to see if a supported endpoint is being manipulated */ + if (EndpointAddress == Microphone_Audio_Interface.Config.DataINEndpoint.Address) + { + /* Check the requested control to see if a supported control is being manipulated */ + if (EndpointControl == AUDIO_EPCONTROL_SamplingFreq) + { + switch (EndpointProperty) + { + case AUDIO_REQ_SetCurrent: + /* Check if we are just testing for a valid property, or actually adjusting it */ + if (DataLength != NULL) + { + /* Set the new sampling frequency to the value given by the host */ + CurrentAudioSampleFrequency = (((uint32_t)Data[2] << 16) | ((uint32_t)Data[1] << 8) | (uint32_t)Data[0]); + + /* Adjust sample reload timer to the new frequency */ + OCR0A = ((F_CPU / 8 / CurrentAudioSampleFrequency) - 1); + } + + return true; + case AUDIO_REQ_GetCurrent: + /* Check if we are just testing for a valid property, or actually reading it */ + if (DataLength != NULL) + { + *DataLength = 3; + + Data[2] = (CurrentAudioSampleFrequency >> 16); + Data[1] = (CurrentAudioSampleFrequency >> 8); + Data[0] = (CurrentAudioSampleFrequency & 0xFF); + } + + return true; + } + } + } + + return false; +} + +/** Audio class driver callback for the setting and retrieval of streaming interface properties. This callback must be implemented + * in the user application to handle property manipulations on streaming audio interfaces. + * + * When the DataLength parameter is NULL, this callback should only indicate whether the specified operation is valid for + * the given entity and should return as fast as possible. When non-NULL, this value may be altered for GET operations + * to indicate the size of the retrieved data. + * + * \note The length of the retrieved data stored into the Data buffer on GET operations should not exceed the initial value + * of the \c DataLength parameter. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] Property Property of the interface to get or set, a value from Audio_ClassRequests_t. + * \param[in] EntityAddress Address of the audio entity whose property is being referenced. + * \param[in] Parameter Parameter of the entity to get or set, specific to each type of entity (see USB Audio specification). + * \param[in,out] DataLength For SET operations, the length of the parameter data to set. For GET operations, the maximum + * length of the retrieved data. When NULL, the function should return whether the given property + * and parameter is valid for the requested endpoint without reading or modifying the Data buffer. + * \param[in,out] Data Pointer to a location where the parameter data is stored for SET operations, or where + * the retrieved data is to be stored for GET operations. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the property GET/SET was successful, \c false otherwise + */ +bool CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetInterfaceProperty(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t Property, + const uint8_t EntityAddress, + const uint16_t Parameter, + uint16_t* const DataLength, + uint8_t* Data) +{ + /* No audio interface entities in the device descriptor, thus no properties to get or set. */ + return false; +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/AudioInput.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/AudioInput.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1deaa76885 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/AudioInput.h @@ -0,0 +1,94 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for AudioInput.c. + */ + +#ifndef _AUDIO_INPUT_H_ +#define _AUDIO_INPUT_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/ADC.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Maximum audio sample value for the microphone input. */ + #define SAMPLE_MAX_RANGE 0xFFFF + + /** Maximum ADC range for the microphone input. */ + #define ADC_MAX_RANGE 0x3FF + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + + bool CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetEndpointProperty(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t EndpointProperty, + const uint8_t EndpointAddress, + const uint8_t EndpointControl, + uint16_t* const DataLength, + uint8_t* Data) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + bool CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetInterfaceProperty(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t Property, + const uint8_t EntityAddress, + const uint16_t Parameter, + uint16_t* const DataLength, + uint8_t* Data); +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/AudioInput.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/AudioInput.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4b0594244d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/AudioInput.txt @@ -0,0 +1,92 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Audio Input Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Audio Class</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Standard Audio Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Audio 1.0 Class Specification \n + * USBIF Audio 1.0 Class Terminal Types Specification \n + * USBIF Audio 1.0 Data Formats Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Audio demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Audio Input device using the + * basic USB Audio 1.0 drivers in all modern OSes (i.e. no special drivers + * required). + * + * On start-up the system will automatically enumerate and function as a + * USB microphone. By default, the demo will produce a square wave test tone + * when the board button is pressed. If USE_TEST_TONE is not defined in the + * project makefile, incoming audio from the ADC channel 1 will be sampled + * and sent to the host computer instead. + * + * When in microphone mode, connect a microphone to the ADC channel 2. + * + * Under Windows, if a driver request dialogue pops up, select the option + * to automatically install the appropriate drivers. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MIC_IN_ADC_CHANNEL</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Sets the ADC channel used by the demo for the input audio samples from an attached microphone.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>USE_TEST_TONE</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, this alters the demo to produce a square wave test tone when the first board button is pressed + * instead of sampling the board microphone.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MICROPHONE_BIASED_TO_HALF_RAIL</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, this alters the demo so that the half VCC bias of the microphone input is subtracted.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ff8ed270de --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,51 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define MIC_IN_ADC_CHANNEL 2 + + #define MICROPHONE_BIASED_TO_HALF_RAIL + #define USE_TEST_TONE + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6048c1d809 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..82cb337da6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,312 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(2,0,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2047, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,2), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .Audio_ControlInterface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioControl, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 0, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_ControlSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_ControlProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_ControlInterface_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .ACSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,0,0), + .TotalLength = (sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t) + + sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_InputTerminal_t) + + sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_OutputTerminal_t)), + + .InCollection = 1, + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + }, + + .Audio_InputTerminal = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_InputTerminal_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_InputTerminal, + + .TerminalID = 0x01, + .TerminalType = AUDIO_TERMINAL_IN_MIC, + .AssociatedOutputTerminal = 0x00, + + .TotalChannels = 1, + .ChannelConfig = 0, + + .ChannelStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + .TerminalStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_OutputTerminal = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_OutputTerminal_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_OutputTerminal, + + .TerminalID = 0x02, + .TerminalType = AUDIO_TERMINAL_STREAMING, + .AssociatedInputTerminal = 0x00, + + .SourceID = 0x01, + + .TerminalStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface_Alt0 = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 0, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioStreamingSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_StreamingProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface_Alt1 = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + .AlternateSetting = 1, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioStreamingSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_StreamingProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AS_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_General, + + .TerminalLink = 0x02, + + .FrameDelay = 1, + .AudioFormat = 0x0001 + }, + + .Audio_AudioFormat = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Format_t) + + sizeof(ConfigurationDescriptor.Audio_AudioFormatSampleRates), + .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_FormatType, + + .FormatType = 0x01, + .Channels = 0x01, + + .SubFrameSize = 0x02, + .BitResolution = 16, + + .TotalDiscreteSampleRates = (sizeof(ConfigurationDescriptor.Audio_AudioFormatSampleRates) / sizeof(USB_Audio_SampleFreq_t)) + }, + + .Audio_AudioFormatSampleRates = + { + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(8000), + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(11025), + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(22050), + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(44100), + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(48000), + }, + + .Audio_StreamEndpoint = + { + .Endpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = AUDIO_STREAM_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS | ENDPOINT_ATTR_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = AUDIO_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x01 + }, + + .Refresh = 0, + .SyncEndpointNumber = 0 + }, + + .Audio_StreamEndpoint_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Spc_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSEndpoint}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSEndpoint_General, + + .Attributes = (AUDIO_EP_ACCEPTS_SMALL_PACKETS | AUDIO_EP_SAMPLE_FREQ_CONTROL), + + .LockDelayUnits = 0x00, + .LockDelay = 0x0000 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Audio In Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bb73220a27 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,106 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Audio isochronous streaming data IN endpoint. */ + #define AUDIO_STREAM_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Endpoint size in bytes of the Audio isochronous streaming data endpoint. */ + #define AUDIO_STREAM_EPSIZE 256 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Audio Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_ControlInterface; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t Audio_ControlInterface_SPC; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_InputTerminal_t Audio_InputTerminal; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_OutputTerminal_t Audio_OutputTerminal; + + // Audio Streaming Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_StreamInterface_Alt0; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_StreamInterface_Alt1; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AS_t Audio_StreamInterface_SPC; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_Format_t Audio_AudioFormat; + USB_Audio_SampleFreq_t Audio_AudioFormatSampleRates[5]; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t Audio_StreamEndpoint; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Spc_t Audio_StreamEndpoint_SPC; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_AudioControl = 0, /**< Audio control interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream = 1, /**< Audio stream interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..466de73033 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,52 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Audio Input Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.audio_input.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.audio_input"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.class.audio_input" caption="Audio Input Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Audio 1.0 Input device demo, implementing a basic USB microphone. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="Audio Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="AudioInput.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="AudioInput.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="AudioInput.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.adc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d52d22cdcb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Audio Input Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..db4048243a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioInput/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = AudioInput +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4c78deb9f6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.c @@ -0,0 +1,311 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the AudioOutput demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "AudioOutput.h" + +/** LUFA Audio Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all Audio Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t Speaker_Audio_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .ControlInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioControl, + .StreamingInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = AUDIO_STREAM_EPADDR, + .Size = AUDIO_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 2, + }, + }, + }; + +/** Current audio sampling frequency of the streaming audio endpoint. */ +static uint32_t CurrentAudioSampleFrequency = 48000; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + Audio_Device_USBTask(&Speaker_Audio_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** ISR to handle the reloading of the PWM timer with the next sample. */ +ISR(TIMER0_COMPA_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + uint8_t PrevEndpoint = Endpoint_GetCurrentEndpoint(); + + /* Check that the USB bus is ready for the next sample to read */ + if (Audio_Device_IsSampleReceived(&Speaker_Audio_Interface)) + { + /* Retrieve the signed 16-bit left and right audio samples, convert to 8-bit */ + int8_t LeftSample_8Bit = (Audio_Device_ReadSample16(&Speaker_Audio_Interface) >> 8); + int8_t RightSample_8Bit = (Audio_Device_ReadSample16(&Speaker_Audio_Interface) >> 8); + + /* Mix the two channels together to produce a mono, 8-bit sample */ + int8_t MixedSample_8Bit = (((int16_t)LeftSample_8Bit + (int16_t)RightSample_8Bit) >> 1); + + #if defined(AUDIO_OUT_MONO) + /* Load the sample into the PWM timer channel */ + OCR3A = (MixedSample_8Bit ^ (1 << 7)); + #elif defined(AUDIO_OUT_STEREO) + /* Load the dual 8-bit samples into the PWM timer channels */ + OCR3A = (LeftSample_8Bit ^ (1 << 7)); + OCR3B = (RightSample_8Bit ^ (1 << 7)); + #elif defined(AUDIO_OUT_PORTC) + /* Load the 8-bit mixed sample into PORTC */ + PORTC = MixedSample_8Bit; + #endif + + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS; + + /* Turn on LEDs as the sample amplitude increases */ + if (MixedSample_8Bit > 16) + LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4); + else if (MixedSample_8Bit > 8) + LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3); + else if (MixedSample_8Bit > 4) + LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2); + else if (MixedSample_8Bit > 2) + LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); + } + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(PrevEndpoint); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + /* Sample reload timer initialization */ + TIMSK0 = (1 << OCIE0A); + OCR0A = ((F_CPU / 8 / CurrentAudioSampleFrequency) - 1); + TCCR0A = (1 << WGM01); // CTC mode + TCCR0B = (1 << CS01); // Fcpu/8 speed + + #if defined(AUDIO_OUT_MONO) + /* Set speaker as output */ + DDRC |= (1 << 6); + #elif defined(AUDIO_OUT_STEREO) + /* Set speakers as outputs */ + DDRC |= ((1 << 6) | (1 << 5)); + #elif defined(AUDIO_OUT_PORTC) + /* Set PORTC as outputs */ + DDRC |= 0xFF; + #endif + + #if (defined(AUDIO_OUT_MONO) || defined(AUDIO_OUT_STEREO)) + /* PWM speaker timer initialization */ + TCCR3A = ((1 << WGM30) | (1 << COM3A1) | (1 << COM3A0) + | (1 << COM3B1) | (1 << COM3B0)); // Set on match, clear on TOP + TCCR3B = ((1 << WGM32) | (1 << CS30)); // Fast 8-Bit PWM, F_CPU speed + #endif +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + + /* Stop the sample reload timer */ + TCCR0B = 0; + + #if (defined(AUDIO_OUT_MONO) || defined(AUDIO_OUT_STEREO)) + /* Stop the PWM generation timer */ + TCCR3B = 0; + #endif + + #if defined(AUDIO_OUT_MONO) + /* Set speaker as input to reduce current draw */ + DDRC &= ~(1 << 6); + #elif defined(AUDIO_OUT_STEREO) + /* Set speakers as inputs to reduce current draw */ + DDRC &= ~((1 << 6) | (1 << 5)); + #elif defined(AUDIO_OUT_PORTC) + /* Set PORTC low */ + PORTC = 0x00; + #endif +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= Audio_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Speaker_Audio_Interface); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + Audio_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Speaker_Audio_Interface); +} + +/** Audio class driver callback for the setting and retrieval of streaming endpoint properties. This callback must be implemented + * in the user application to handle property manipulations on streaming audio endpoints. + * + * When the DataLength parameter is NULL, this callback should only indicate whether the specified operation is valid for + * the given endpoint index, and should return as fast as possible. When non-NULL, this value may be altered for GET operations + * to indicate the size of the retrieved data. + * + * \note The length of the retrieved data stored into the Data buffer on GET operations should not exceed the initial value + * of the \c DataLength parameter. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] EndpointProperty Property of the endpoint to get or set, a value from Audio_ClassRequests_t. + * \param[in] EndpointAddress Address of the streaming endpoint whose property is being referenced. + * \param[in] EndpointControl Parameter of the endpoint to get or set, a value from Audio_EndpointControls_t. + * \param[in,out] DataLength For SET operations, the length of the parameter data to set. For GET operations, the maximum + * length of the retrieved data. When NULL, the function should return whether the given property + * and parameter is valid for the requested endpoint without reading or modifying the Data buffer. + * \param[in,out] Data Pointer to a location where the parameter data is stored for SET operations, or where + * the retrieved data is to be stored for GET operations. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the property get/set was successful, \c false otherwise + */ +bool CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetEndpointProperty(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t EndpointProperty, + const uint8_t EndpointAddress, + const uint8_t EndpointControl, + uint16_t* const DataLength, + uint8_t* Data) +{ + /* Check the requested endpoint to see if a supported endpoint is being manipulated */ + if (EndpointAddress == Speaker_Audio_Interface.Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Address) + { + /* Check the requested control to see if a supported control is being manipulated */ + if (EndpointControl == AUDIO_EPCONTROL_SamplingFreq) + { + switch (EndpointProperty) + { + case AUDIO_REQ_SetCurrent: + /* Check if we are just testing for a valid property, or actually adjusting it */ + if (DataLength != NULL) + { + /* Set the new sampling frequency to the value given by the host */ + CurrentAudioSampleFrequency = (((uint32_t)Data[2] << 16) | ((uint32_t)Data[1] << 8) | (uint32_t)Data[0]); + + /* Adjust sample reload timer to the new frequency */ + OCR0A = ((F_CPU / 8 / CurrentAudioSampleFrequency) - 1); + } + + return true; + case AUDIO_REQ_GetCurrent: + /* Check if we are just testing for a valid property, or actually reading it */ + if (DataLength != NULL) + { + *DataLength = 3; + + Data[2] = (CurrentAudioSampleFrequency >> 16); + Data[1] = (CurrentAudioSampleFrequency >> 8); + Data[0] = (CurrentAudioSampleFrequency & 0xFF); + } + + return true; + } + } + } + + return false; +} + +/** Audio class driver callback for the setting and retrieval of streaming interface properties. This callback must be implemented + * in the user application to handle property manipulations on streaming audio interfaces. + * + * When the DataLength parameter is NULL, this callback should only indicate whether the specified operation is valid for + * the given entity and should return as fast as possible. When non-NULL, this value may be altered for GET operations + * to indicate the size of the retrieved data. + * + * \note The length of the retrieved data stored into the Data buffer on GET operations should not exceed the initial value + * of the \c DataLength parameter. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] Property Property of the interface to get or set, a value from Audio_ClassRequests_t. + * \param[in] EntityAddress Address of the audio entity whose property is being referenced. + * \param[in] Parameter Parameter of the entity to get or set, specific to each type of entity (see USB Audio specification). + * \param[in,out] DataLength For SET operations, the length of the parameter data to set. For GET operations, the maximum + * length of the retrieved data. When NULL, the function should return whether the given property + * and parameter is valid for the requested endpoint without reading or modifying the Data buffer. + * \param[in,out] Data Pointer to a location where the parameter data is stored for SET operations, or where + * the retrieved data is to be stored for GET operations. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the property GET/SET was successful, \c false otherwise + */ +bool CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetInterfaceProperty(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t Property, + const uint8_t EntityAddress, + const uint16_t Parameter, + uint16_t* const DataLength, + uint8_t* Data) +{ + /* No audio interface entities in the device descriptor, thus no properties to get or set. */ + return false; +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4dbec315e2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.h @@ -0,0 +1,87 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for AudioOutput.c. + */ + +#ifndef _AUDIO_OUTPUT_H_ +#define _AUDIO_OUTPUT_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdlib.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + + bool CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetEndpointProperty(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t EndpointProperty, + const uint8_t EndpointAddress, + const uint8_t EndpointControl, + uint16_t* const DataLength, + uint8_t* Data) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + bool CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetInterfaceProperty(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t Property, + const uint8_t EntityAddress, + const uint16_t Parameter, + uint16_t* const DataLength, + uint8_t* Data); +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8f0c7d656c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.txt @@ -0,0 +1,92 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Audio Output Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Audio Class</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Standard Audio Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Audio 1.0 Class Specification \n + * USBIF Audio 1.0 Class Terminal Types Specification \n + * USBIF Audio 1.0 Data Formats Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Audio demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Audio Output device using the + * basic USB Audio 1.0 drivers in all modern OSes (i.e. no special drivers + * required). + * + * On start-up the system will automatically enumerate and function + * as a USB speaker. Outgoing audio will output in 8-bit PWM onto + * the timer 3 output compare channel A for AUDIO_OUT_MONO mode, on + * timer 3 channels A and B for AUDIO_OUT_STEREO and on PORTC as a signed + * mono sample for AUDIO_OUT_PORTC. Audio output will also be indicated on + * the board LEDs in all modes. Decouple audio outputs with a capacitor and + * attach to a speaker to hear the audio. + * + * Under Windows, if a driver request dialogue pops up, select the option + * to automatically install the appropriate drivers. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AUDIO_OUT_STEREO</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, this outputs the audio samples in stereo to the timer output pins of the microcontroller.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AUDIO_OUT_MONO</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, this outputs the audio samples in mono to the timer output pin of the microcontroller.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AUDIO_OUT_PORTC</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, this outputs the audio samples in mono to port C of the microcontroller, for connection to an + * external DAC.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e93cfc8136 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define AUDIO_OUT_STEREO +// #define AUDIO_OUT_MONO +// #define AUDIO_OUT_PORTC + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6048c1d809 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..42bd528bca --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,312 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(2,0,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2046, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,2), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .Audio_ControlInterface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioControl, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 0, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_ControlSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_ControlProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_ControlInterface_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .ACSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,0,0), + .TotalLength = (sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t) + + sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_InputTerminal_t) + + sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_OutputTerminal_t)), + + .InCollection = 1, + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + }, + + .Audio_InputTerminal = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_InputTerminal_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_InputTerminal, + + .TerminalID = 0x01, + .TerminalType = AUDIO_TERMINAL_STREAMING, + .AssociatedOutputTerminal = 0x00, + + .TotalChannels = 2, + .ChannelConfig = (AUDIO_CHANNEL_LEFT_FRONT | AUDIO_CHANNEL_RIGHT_FRONT), + + .ChannelStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + .TerminalStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_OutputTerminal = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_OutputTerminal_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_OutputTerminal, + + .TerminalID = 0x02, + .TerminalType = AUDIO_TERMINAL_OUT_SPEAKER, + .AssociatedInputTerminal = 0x00, + + .SourceID = 0x01, + + .TerminalStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface_Alt0 = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 0, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioStreamingSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_StreamingProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface_Alt1 = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + .AlternateSetting = 1, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioStreamingSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_StreamingProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AS_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_General, + + .TerminalLink = 0x01, + + .FrameDelay = 1, + .AudioFormat = 0x0001 + }, + + .Audio_AudioFormat = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Format_t) + + sizeof(ConfigurationDescriptor.Audio_AudioFormatSampleRates), + .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_FormatType, + + .FormatType = 0x01, + .Channels = 0x02, + + .SubFrameSize = 0x02, + .BitResolution = 16, + + .TotalDiscreteSampleRates = (sizeof(ConfigurationDescriptor.Audio_AudioFormatSampleRates) / sizeof(USB_Audio_SampleFreq_t)), + }, + + .Audio_AudioFormatSampleRates = + { + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(8000), + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(11025), + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(22050), + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(44100), + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(48000), + }, + + .Audio_StreamEndpoint = + { + .Endpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = AUDIO_STREAM_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS | ENDPOINT_ATTR_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = AUDIO_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x01 + }, + + .Refresh = 0, + .SyncEndpointNumber = 0 + }, + + .Audio_StreamEndpoint_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Spc_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSEndpoint}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSEndpoint_General, + + .Attributes = (AUDIO_EP_ACCEPTS_SMALL_PACKETS | AUDIO_EP_SAMPLE_FREQ_CONTROL), + + .LockDelayUnits = 0x00, + .LockDelay = 0x0000 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Audio Out Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3774cc5409 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,106 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Audio isochronous streaming data OUT endpoint. */ + #define AUDIO_STREAM_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 1) + + /** Endpoint size in bytes of the Audio isochronous streaming data endpoint. */ + #define AUDIO_STREAM_EPSIZE 256 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Audio Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_ControlInterface; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t Audio_ControlInterface_SPC; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_InputTerminal_t Audio_InputTerminal; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_OutputTerminal_t Audio_OutputTerminal; + + // Audio Streaming Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_StreamInterface_Alt0; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_StreamInterface_Alt1; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AS_t Audio_StreamInterface_SPC; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_Format_t Audio_AudioFormat; + USB_Audio_SampleFreq_t Audio_AudioFormatSampleRates[5]; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t Audio_StreamEndpoint; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Spc_t Audio_StreamEndpoint_SPC; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_AudioControl = 0, /**< Audio control interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream = 1, /**< Audio stream interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f46f3a0f19 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Audio Output Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.audio_output.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.audio_output"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.class.audio_output" caption="Audio Output Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Audio 1.0 Output device demo, implementing a basic USB speaker. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="Audio Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="AudioOutput.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="AudioOutput.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="AudioOutput.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..937ef3907b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Audio Output Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = YES + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dc4c7bb1c3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/AudioOutput/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = AudioOutput +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..00eefc7bf7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 2 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a286c5e9e0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,366 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x206D, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,2), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .Audio_ControlInterface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioControl, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 0, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_ControlSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_ControlProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_ControlInterface_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .ACSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,0,0), + .TotalLength = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t), + + .InCollection = 1, + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_MIDIStreamingSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_StreamingProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_AudioInterface_AS_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_General, + + .AudioSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,0,0), + + .TotalLength = (sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t) - + offsetof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t, Audio_StreamInterface_SPC)) + }, + + .MIDI_In_Jack_Emb = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_InputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_Embedded, + .JackID = 0x01, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_In_Jack_Emb2 = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_InputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_Embedded, + .JackID = 0x02, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_In_Jack_Ext = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_InputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_External, + .JackID = 0x03, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_In_Jack_Ext2 = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_InputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_External, + .JackID = 0x04, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_Out_Jack_Emb = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_OutputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_Embedded, + .JackID = 0x05, + + .NumberOfPins = 1, + .SourceJackID = {0x03}, + .SourcePinID = {0x01}, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_Out_Jack_Emb2 = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_OutputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_Embedded, + .JackID = 0x06, + + .NumberOfPins = 1, + .SourceJackID = {0x04}, + .SourcePinID = {0x01}, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_Out_Jack_Ext = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_OutputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_External, + .JackID = 0x07, + + .NumberOfPins = 1, + .SourceJackID = {0x01}, + .SourcePinID = {0x01}, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_Out_Jack_Ext2 = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_OutputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_External, + .JackID = 0x08, + + .NumberOfPins = 1, + .SourceJackID = {0x02}, + .SourcePinID = {0x01}, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_In_Jack_Endpoint = + { + .Endpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MIDI_STREAM_OUT_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .Refresh = 0, + .SyncEndpointNumber = 0 + }, + + .MIDI_In_Jack_Endpoint_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_DualJack_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSEndpoint}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSEndpoint_General, + + .TotalEmbeddedJacks = 0x02, + .AssociatedJackID = {0x01, 0x02} + }, + + .MIDI_Out_Jack_Endpoint = + { + .Endpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MIDI_STREAM_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .Refresh = 0, + .SyncEndpointNumber = 0 + }, + + .MIDI_Out_Jack_Endpoint_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_DualJack_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSEndpoint}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSEndpoint_General, + + .TotalEmbeddedJacks = 0x02, + .AssociatedJackID = {0x05, 0x06} + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Dual MIDI Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a7ce6d2cd6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,124 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the MIDI streaming data IN endpoint, for device-to-host data transfers. */ + #define MIDI_STREAM_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 2) + + /** Endpoint address of the MIDI streaming data OUT endpoint, for host-to-device data transfers. */ + #define MIDI_STREAM_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 1) + + /** Endpoint size in bytes of the Audio isochronous streaming data IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE 64 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a dual jack endpoint descriptor. This is identical to the LUFA MIDI class driver's + * USB_MIDI_Descriptor_Jack_Endpoint_t, except that it contains two jack association entries. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length. */ + uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors. */ + + uint8_t TotalEmbeddedJacks; /**< Total number of jacks inside this endpoint. */ + uint8_t AssociatedJackID[2]; /**< IDs of each jack inside the endpoint. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_MIDI_Descriptor_DualJack_Endpoint_t; + + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // MIDI Audio Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_ControlInterface; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t Audio_ControlInterface_SPC; + + // MIDI Audio Streaming Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_StreamInterface; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_AudioInterface_AS_t Audio_StreamInterface_SPC; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t MIDI_In_Jack_Emb; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t MIDI_In_Jack_Emb2; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t MIDI_In_Jack_Ext; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t MIDI_In_Jack_Ext2; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t MIDI_Out_Jack_Emb; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t MIDI_Out_Jack_Emb2; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t MIDI_Out_Jack_Ext; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t MIDI_Out_Jack_Ext2; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t MIDI_In_Jack_Endpoint; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_DualJack_Endpoint_t MIDI_In_Jack_Endpoint_SPC; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t MIDI_Out_Jack_Endpoint; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_DualJack_Endpoint_t MIDI_Out_Jack_Endpoint_SPC; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_AudioControl = 0, /**< Audio control interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream = 1, /**< Audio streaming interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/DualMIDI.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/DualMIDI.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b31f602498 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/DualMIDI.c @@ -0,0 +1,211 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the Dual MIDI demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "DualMIDI.h" + +/** LUFA MIDI Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all MIDI Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Device_t Keyboard_MIDI_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .StreamingInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = MIDI_STREAM_IN_EPADDR, + .Size = MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = MIDI_STREAM_OUT_EPADDR, + .Size = MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + CheckJoystickMovement(); + + MIDI_EventPacket_t ReceivedMIDIEvent; + while (MIDI_Device_ReceiveEventPacket(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface, &ReceivedMIDIEvent)) + { + if ((ReceivedMIDIEvent.Event == MIDI_EVENT(0, MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON)) && (ReceivedMIDIEvent.Data3 > 0)) + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ReceivedMIDIEvent.Data2 > 64 ? LEDS_LED1 : LEDS_LED2); + else + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDS_NO_LEDS); + } + + MIDI_Device_USBTask(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Joystick_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + Buttons_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Checks for changes in the position of the board joystick, sending MIDI events to the host upon each change. */ +void CheckJoystickMovement(void) +{ + static uint8_t PrevJoystickStatus; + + uint8_t MIDICommand = 0; + uint8_t MIDIPitch; + + /* Get current joystick mask, XOR with previous to detect joystick changes */ + uint8_t JoystickStatus = Joystick_GetStatus(); + uint8_t JoystickChanges = (JoystickStatus ^ PrevJoystickStatus); + + /* Get board button status - if pressed use second virtual cable, otherwise use the first */ + uint8_t VirtualCable = (Buttons_GetStatus() & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ? 1 : 0; + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_LEFT) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_LEFT)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3C; + } + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_UP) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_UP)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3D; + } + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_RIGHT) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_RIGHT)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3E; + } + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_DOWN) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_DOWN)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3F; + } + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_PRESS) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_PRESS)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3B; + } + + if (MIDICommand) + { + MIDI_EventPacket_t MIDIEvent = (MIDI_EventPacket_t) + { + .Event = MIDI_EVENT(VirtualCable, MIDICommand), + + .Data1 = MIDICommand | MIDI_CHANNEL(1), + .Data2 = MIDIPitch, + .Data3 = MIDI_STANDARD_VELOCITY, + }; + + MIDI_Device_SendEventPacket(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface, &MIDIEvent); + MIDI_Device_Flush(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface); + } + + PrevJoystickStatus = JoystickStatus; +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= MIDI_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + MIDI_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/DualMIDI.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/DualMIDI.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3b0dac3be3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/DualMIDI.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for DualMIDI.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DUAL_MIDI_H_ +#define _DUAL_MIDI_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void CheckJoystickMovement(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/DualMIDI.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/DualMIDI.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..19d4dbc04b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/DualMIDI.txt @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage MIDI Dual Input Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Audio Class</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Standard Audio Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Audio Class Specification \n + * USB-MIDI Audio Class Extension Specification \n + * General MIDI Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Dual MIDI demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing the USB-MIDI class in USB devices. + * It is built upon the USB Audio class. + * + * Joystick movements are translated into note on/off messages and + * are sent to the host PC as MIDI streams which can be read by any + * MIDI program supporting MIDI IN devices. + * + * If the HWB is not pressed, the first virtual MIDI cable to the host is + * used. If the HWB is pressed, then the second virtual cable is selected. + * + * This device implements MIDI-THRU mode, with the IN MIDI data being + * generated by the device itself. OUT MIDI data is discarded. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ba85a3b56b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0"> + <project caption="Dual MIDI Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.dual_midi.example.avr8"> + <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.dual_midi"/> + <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> + <generator value="as5_8"/> + + <device-support value="at90usb1287"/> + <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> + + <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> + <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> + </project> + + <project caption="MIDI Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.dual_midi.example.xmega"> + <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.dual_midi"/> + <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/> + <generator value="as5_8"/> + + <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/> + <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> + + <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/> + <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/> + </project> + + <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.class.dual_midi" caption="Dual MIDI Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Dual MIDI device demo, implementing a basic USB MIDI device with two virtual cables that can send messages to the host. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack. + </info> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/> + + <info type="keyword" value="Technology"> + <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/> + <keyword value="USB Device"/> + <keyword value="MIDI Class"/> + </info> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/> + <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="DualMIDI.txt"/> + + <build type="c-source" value="DualMIDI.c"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="DualMIDI.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/> + + <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/> + + <require idref="lufa.common"/> + <require idref="lufa.platform"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/> + </module> +</asf> diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..879aae3e87 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Dual MIDI Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..04e06d1df6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualMIDI/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = DualMIDI +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..070eac4712 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 6 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..553223a2b8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,360 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_IADDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_IADDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_IADDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x204E, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 4, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .CDC1_IAD = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_Association_t), .Type = DTYPE_InterfaceAssociation}, + + .FirstInterfaceIndex = INTERFACE_ID_CDC1_CCI, + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .IADStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC1_CCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC1_CCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC1_Functional_Header = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .CDCSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + }, + + .CDC1_Functional_ACM = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ACM, + + .Capabilities = 0x06, + }, + + .CDC1_Functional_Union = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Union, + + .MasterInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC1_CCI, + .SlaveInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC1_DCI, + }, + + .CDC1_ManagementEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC1_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0xFF + }, + + .CDC1_DCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC1_DCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC1_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC1_RX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .CDC1_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC1_TX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .CDC2_IAD = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_Association_t), .Type = DTYPE_InterfaceAssociation}, + + .FirstInterfaceIndex = INTERFACE_ID_CDC2_CCI, + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .IADStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC2_CCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC2_CCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC2_Functional_Header = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .CDCSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + }, + + .CDC2_Functional_ACM = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ACM, + + .Capabilities = 0x06, + }, + + .CDC2_Functional_Union = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Union, + + .MasterInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC2_CCI, + .SlaveInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC2_DCI, + }, + + .CDC2_ManagementEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC2_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0xFF + }, + + .CDC2_DCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC2_DCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC2_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC2_RX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .CDC2_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC2_TX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Dual CDC Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dfc7a77930 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,135 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the first CDC interface's device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC1_TX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Endpoint address of the first CDC interface's host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define CDC1_RX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /** Endpoint address of the first CDC interface's device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC1_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the second CDC interface's device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC2_TX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 4) + + /** Endpoint address of the second CDC interface's host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define CDC2_RX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 5) + + /** Endpoint address of the second CDC interface's device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC2_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 6) + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoints. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE 8 + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC data IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE 16 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // First CDC Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_Association_t CDC1_IAD; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC1_CCI_Interface; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t CDC1_Functional_Header; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t CDC1_Functional_ACM; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t CDC1_Functional_Union; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC1_ManagementEndpoint; + + // First CDC Data Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC1_DCI_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC1_DataOutEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC1_DataInEndpoint; + + // Second CDC Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_Association_t CDC2_IAD; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC2_CCI_Interface; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t CDC2_Functional_Header; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t CDC2_Functional_ACM; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t CDC2_Functional_Union; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC2_ManagementEndpoint; + + // Second CDC Data Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC2_DCI_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC2_DataOutEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC2_DataInEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_CDC1_CCI = 0, /**< CDC1 CCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_CDC1_DCI = 1, /**< CDC1 DCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_CDC2_CCI = 2, /**< CDC2 CCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_CDC2_DCI = 3, /**< CDC2 DCI interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/DualVirtualSerial.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/DualVirtualSerial.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9a7ff4725e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/DualVirtualSerial.c @@ -0,0 +1,242 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the DualVirtualSerial demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "DualVirtualSerial.h" + +/** LUFA CDC Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all CDC Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. This is for the first CDC interface, + * which sends strings to the host for each joystick movement. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t VirtualSerial1_CDC_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .ControlInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC1_CCI, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC1_TX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC1_RX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC1_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + }, + }; + +/** LUFA CDC Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all CDC Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. This is for the second CDC interface, + * which echos back all received data from the host. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t VirtualSerial2_CDC_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .ControlInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC2_CCI, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC2_TX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC2_RX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC2_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + CheckJoystickMovement(); + + /* Discard all received data on the first CDC interface */ + CDC_Device_ReceiveByte(&VirtualSerial1_CDC_Interface); + + /* Echo all received data on the second CDC interface */ + int16_t ReceivedByte = CDC_Device_ReceiveByte(&VirtualSerial2_CDC_Interface); + if (!(ReceivedByte < 0)) + CDC_Device_SendByte(&VirtualSerial2_CDC_Interface, (uint8_t)ReceivedByte); + + CDC_Device_USBTask(&VirtualSerial1_CDC_Interface); + CDC_Device_USBTask(&VirtualSerial2_CDC_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Joystick_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Checks for changes in the position of the board joystick, sending strings to the host upon each change + * through the first of the CDC interfaces. + */ +void CheckJoystickMovement(void) +{ + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + char* ReportString = NULL; + static bool ActionSent = false; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + ReportString = "Joystick Up\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + ReportString = "Joystick Down\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + ReportString = "Joystick Left\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + ReportString = "Joystick Right\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + ReportString = "Joystick Pressed\r\n"; + else + ActionSent = false; + + if ((ReportString != NULL) && (ActionSent == false)) + { + ActionSent = true; + + CDC_Device_SendString(&VirtualSerial1_CDC_Interface, ReportString); + } +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= CDC_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&VirtualSerial1_CDC_Interface); + ConfigSuccess &= CDC_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&VirtualSerial2_CDC_Interface); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + CDC_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&VirtualSerial1_CDC_Interface); + CDC_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&VirtualSerial2_CDC_Interface); +} + +/** CDC class driver callback function the processing of changes to the virtual + * control lines sent from the host.. + * + * \param[in] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to the CDC class interface configuration structure being referenced + */ +void EVENT_CDC_Device_ControLineStateChanged(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t *const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + /* You can get changes to the virtual CDC lines in this callback; a common + use-case is to use the Data Terminal Ready (DTR) flag to enable and + disable CDC communications in your application when set to avoid the + application blocking while waiting for a host to become ready and read + in the pending data from the USB endpoints. + */ + bool HostReady = (CDCInterfaceInfo->State.ControlLineStates.HostToDevice & CDC_CONTROL_LINE_OUT_DTR) != 0; + + if (CDCInterfaceInfo == &VirtualSerial1_CDC_Interface) + { + // CDC interface 1's host is ready to send/receive data + } + else + { + // CDC interface 2's host is ready to send/receive data + } +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/DualVirtualSerial.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/DualVirtualSerial.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..28d125adf7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/DualVirtualSerial.h @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for DualVirtualSerial.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DUAL_VIRTUALSERIAL_H_ +#define _DUAL_VIRTUALSERIAL_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void CheckJoystickMovement(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/DualVirtualSerial.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/DualVirtualSerial.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c325e9ced9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/DualVirtualSerial.txt @@ -0,0 +1,89 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Dual Communications Device Class (Dual Virtual Serial Port) Device + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Abstract Control Model (ACM)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF CDC Class Standard</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Interface Association Descriptor ECN \n + * USBIF CDC Class Standard</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Dual Communications Device Class demonstration application. + * This gives a simple reference application for implementing + * a composite device with dual CDC functions acting as a pair + * of virtual serial ports. This demo uses Interface Association + * Descriptors to link together the pair of related CDC + * descriptors for each virtual serial port, which may not be + * supported in all OSes - Windows Vista is supported, as is + * XP (although the latter may need a hotfix to function). + * + * Joystick actions are transmitted to the host as strings + * through the first serial port. The device does not respond to + * serial data sent from the host in the first serial port. + * + * The second serial port echoes back data sent from the host. + * + * After running this demo for the first time on a new computer, + * you will need to supply the .INF file located in this demo + * project's directory as the device's driver when running under + * Windows. This will enable Windows to use its inbuilt CDC drivers, + * negating the need for custom drivers for the device. Other + * Operating Systems should automatically use their own inbuilt + * CDC-ACM drivers. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/LUFA DualVirtualSerial.inf b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/LUFA DualVirtualSerial.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1a0e0248af --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/LUFA DualVirtualSerial.inf @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +;************************************************************ +; Windows USB CDC ACM Setup File +; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation +;************************************************************ + +[DefaultInstall] +CopyINF="LUFA DualVirtualSerial.inf" + +[Version] +Signature="$Windows NT$" +Class=Ports +ClassGuid={4D36E978-E325-11CE-BFC1-08002BE10318} +Provider=%MFGNAME% +DriverVer=7/1/2012,10.0.0.0 + +[Manufacturer] +%MFGNAME%=DeviceList, NTx86, NTamd64, NTia64 + +[SourceDisksNames] + +[SourceDisksFiles] + +[DestinationDirs] +DefaultDestDir=12 + +[DriverInstall] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +CopyFiles=FakeModemCopyFileSection +AddReg=DriverInstall.AddReg + +[DriverInstall.Services] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +AddService=usbser, 0x00000002, LowerFilter_Service_Inst + +[DriverInstall.AddReg] +HKR,,EnumPropPages32,,"msports.dll,SerialPortPropPageProvider" + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; Vendor and Product ID Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; When developing your USB device, the VID and PID used in the PC side +; application program and the firmware on the microcontroller must match. +; Modify the below line to use your VID and PID. Use the format as shown below. +; Note: One INF file can be used for multiple devices with different VID and PIDs. +; For each supported device, append ",USB\VID_xxxx&PID_yyyy" to the end of the line. +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[DeviceList] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204E&MI_00, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204E&MI_02 + +[DeviceList.NTx86] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204E&MI_00, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204E&MI_02 + +[DeviceList.NTamd64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204E&MI_00, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204E&MI_02 + +[DeviceList.NTia64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204E&MI_00, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204E&MI_02 + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; String Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +;Modify these strings to customize your device +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[Strings] +MFGNAME="http://www.lufa-lib.org" +DESCRIPTION="LUFA CDC-ACM Virtual Serial Port"
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e00f339954 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Dual Virtual Serial Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.dual_cdc.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.dual_cdc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Dual Virtual Serial Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.dual_cdc.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.dual_cdc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.class.dual_cdc" caption="Dual Virtual Serial Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Dual Virtual Serial (CDC) demo, implementing a pair of virtual serial port interfaces. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="CDC Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="DualVirtualSerial.txt"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="LUFA DualVirtualSerial.inf"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="DualVirtualSerial.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="DualVirtualSerial.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..40dcfe9157 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Dual Virtual Serial Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3bdd0259bb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/DualVirtualSerial/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = DualVirtualSerial +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..636200ec6d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define GENERIC_REPORT_SIZE 8 + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..299d2ec852 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 1 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c0f1b0de97 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,220 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the + * USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This + * descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding) + * the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for + * more details on HID report descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t PROGMEM GenericReport[] = +{ + /* Use the HID class driver's standard Vendor HID report. + * Vendor Usage Page: 0 + * Vendor Collection Usage: 1 + * Vendor Report IN Usage: 2 + * Vendor Report OUT Usage: 3 + * Vendor Report Size: GENERIC_REPORT_SIZE + */ + HID_DESCRIPTOR_VENDOR(0x00, 0x01, 0x02, 0x03, GENERIC_REPORT_SIZE) +}; + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x204F, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .HID_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_GenericHID, + .AlternateSetting = 0x00, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_NonBootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_NonBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID_GenericHID = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(GenericReport) + }, + + .HID_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = GENERIC_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = GENERIC_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Generic HID Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + case HID_DTYPE_HID: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID_GenericHID; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + break; + case HID_DTYPE_Report: + Address = &GenericReport; + Size = sizeof(GenericReport); + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4fa644ff2f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,95 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Generic HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID_Interface; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID_GenericHID; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID_ReportINEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_GenericHID = 0, /**< GenericHID interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Generic HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define GENERIC_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Size in bytes of the Generic HID reporting endpoint. */ + #define GENERIC_EPSIZE 8 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/GenericHID.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/GenericHID.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d7f3e3c23e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/GenericHID.c @@ -0,0 +1,202 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the GenericHID demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "GenericHID.h" + +/** Buffer to hold the previously generated HID report, for comparison purposes inside the HID class driver. */ +static uint8_t PrevHIDReportBuffer[GENERIC_REPORT_SIZE]; + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t Generic_HID_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_GenericHID, + .ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Address = GENERIC_IN_EPADDR, + .Size = GENERIC_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .PrevReportINBuffer = PrevHIDReportBuffer, + .PrevReportINBufferSize = sizeof(PrevHIDReportBuffer), + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + HID_Device_USBTask(&Generic_HID_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= HID_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Generic_HID_Interface); + + USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + HID_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Generic_HID_Interface); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB device Start Of Frame event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void) +{ + HID_Device_MillisecondElapsed(&Generic_HID_Interface); +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the creation of HID reports to the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in,out] ReportID Report ID requested by the host if non-zero, otherwise callback should set to the generated report ID + * \param[in] ReportType Type of the report to create, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_In or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[out] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the created report should be stored + * \param[out] ReportSize Number of bytes written in the report (or zero if no report is to be sent) + * + * \return Boolean \c true to force the sending of the report, \c false to let the library determine if it needs to be sent + */ +bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize) +{ + uint8_t* Data = (uint8_t*)ReportData; + uint8_t CurrLEDMask = LEDs_GetLEDs(); + + Data[0] = ((CurrLEDMask & LEDS_LED1) ? 1 : 0); + Data[1] = ((CurrLEDMask & LEDS_LED2) ? 1 : 0); + Data[2] = ((CurrLEDMask & LEDS_LED3) ? 1 : 0); + Data[3] = ((CurrLEDMask & LEDS_LED4) ? 1 : 0); + + *ReportSize = GENERIC_REPORT_SIZE; + return false; +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the processing of HID reports from the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in] ReportID Report ID of the received report from the host + * \param[in] ReportType The type of report that the host has sent, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_Out or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[in] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the received report has been stored + * \param[in] ReportSize Size in bytes of the received HID report + */ +void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize) +{ + uint8_t* Data = (uint8_t*)ReportData; + uint8_t NewLEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS; + + if (Data[0]) + NewLEDMask |= LEDS_LED1; + + if (Data[1]) + NewLEDMask |= LEDS_LED2; + + if (Data[2]) + NewLEDMask |= LEDS_LED3; + + if (Data[3]) + NewLEDMask |= LEDS_LED4; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(NewLEDMask); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/GenericHID.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/GenericHID.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0528585a63 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/GenericHID.h @@ -0,0 +1,87 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for GenericHID.c. + */ + +#ifndef _GENERICHID_H_ +#define _GENERICHID_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void); + + bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize); + void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/GenericHID.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/GenericHID.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0d780f49d1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/GenericHID.txt @@ -0,0 +1,79 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Generic HID Device + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Generic HID device demonstration application. This gives a simple reference application + * for implementing a generic HID device, using the basic USB HID drivers in all modern + * OSes (i.e. no special drivers required). By default it accepts and sends up to 8 byte reports + * to and from a USB Host, and transmits the last sent report back to the host. + * + * On start-up the system will automatically enumerate and function as a vendor HID device. + * When controlled by a custom HID class application, reports can be sent and received by + * both the standard data endpoint and control request methods defined in the HID specification. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>GENERIC_REPORT_SIZE</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>This token defines the size of the device reports, both sent and received (including report ID byte). The value + * must be an integer ranging from 1 to 255.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/HostTestApp/test_generic_hid_libusb.js b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/HostTestApp/test_generic_hid_libusb.js new file mode 100755 index 0000000000..363786429a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/HostTestApp/test_generic_hid_libusb.js @@ -0,0 +1,143 @@ +#!/usr/bin/env node + +// LUFA Library +// Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +// +// dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +// www.lufa-lib.org + +// LUFA Generic HID device demo host test script. This script will send a +// continuous stream of generic reports to the device, to show a variable LED +// pattern on the target board. Send and received report data is printed to +// the terminal. +// +// You have to install the usb and async modules prior to executing this script: +// apt-get install libusb-1.0-0-dev +// npm install usb async sprintf + +var usb = require('usb'); +var async = require('async'); +var sprintf = require('sprintf'); + +var deviceVid = 0x03EB; +var devicePid = 0x204F; +var reportLength = 8; + +function getAndInitHidDeviceAndInterface() +{ + device = usb.findByIds(deviceVid, devicePid); + if (!device) { + console.log('No device found'); + process.exit(1); + } + device.open(); + + var hidInterface = device.interface(0); + if (hidInterface.isKernelDriverActive()) { + hidInterface.detachKernelDriver(); + } + hidInterface.claim(); + + async.series([ + function(callback) { + setConfiguration(0, function(error, data) { + callback(); + }); + } + ]); + + return {hidDevice:device, hidInterface:hidInterface}; +} + +function read(hidInterface, callback) +{ + endpoint = hidInterface.endpoints[0]; + endpoint.transfer(reportLength, function(error, data) { + if (error) { + console.log(error) + } else { + console.log("Received LED Pattern:", data.slice(0, 4)); + } + callback(); + }); +} + +function write(hidDevice, message, callback) +{ + hidDevice.controlTransfer( // Send a Set Report control request + parseInt('00100001', 2), // bmRequestType (constant for this control request) + 0x09, // bmRequest (constant for this control request) + 0x0809, // wValue (MSB is report type, LSB is report number) + 0, // wIndex (interface number) + message, // message to be sent + function(error, data) { // callback to be executed upon finishing the transfer + console.log("Sent LED Pattern:", message.slice(1, 5)) + callback(); + } + ); +} + +function setConfiguration(configurationNumber, callback) +{ + device.controlTransfer( // Send a Set Configuration control request + parseInt('00000000', 2), // bmRequestType + 0x09, // bmRequest + 0, // wValue (Configuration value) + 0, // wIndex + new Buffer(0), // message to be sent + callback // callback to be executed upon finishing the transfer + ); +} + +// @TODO: Fix this function because apparently it doesn't work for some reason. +function getStringDescriptor(stringId, languageId, callback) +{ + var STRING_DESCRIPTOR_TYPE = 0x03; + var wValue = (STRING_DESCRIPTOR_TYPE << 8) | stringId; + + device.controlTransfer( // Send a Get Descriptor control request + parseInt('10000000', 2), // bmRequestType + 0x06, // bmRequest + wValue, // wValue + languageId, // wIndex + 64, // response length + callback // callback to be executed upon finishing the transfer + ); +} + +function setNextPattern() +{ + var pattern = [ + hidInterface.interface, + (p >> 3) & 1, + (p >> 2) & 1, + (p >> 1) & 1, + (p >> 0) & 1 + ]; + + async.series([ + function(callback) { + write(hidDevice, new Buffer(pattern), callback); + }, + function(callback) { + read(hidInterface, callback); + }, + function(callback) { + p = (p + 1) % 16 + setTimeout(setNextPattern, 200); + callback(); + }]); +} + +var hidDeviceAndInterface = getAndInitHidDeviceAndInterface(); +var hidDevice = hidDeviceAndInterface.hidDevice +var hidInterface = hidDeviceAndInterface.hidInterface; + +console.log(sprintf("Connected to device 0x%04X/0x%04X - %s [%s]", + hidDevice.deviceDescriptor.idVendor, + hidDevice.deviceDescriptor.idProduct, + hidDevice.deviceDescriptor.iProduct, + hidDevice.deviceDescriptor.iManufacturer)); + +p = 0 +setNextPattern(); diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/HostTestApp/test_generic_hid_libusb.py b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/HostTestApp/test_generic_hid_libusb.py new file mode 100755 index 0000000000..4efa4a0ab4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/HostTestApp/test_generic_hid_libusb.py @@ -0,0 +1,98 @@ +#!/usr/bin/env python + +""" + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +""" + +""" + LUFA Generic HID device demo host test script. This script will send a + continuous stream of generic reports to the device, to show a variable LED + pattern on the target board. Send and received report data is printed to + the terminal. + + Requires the PyUSB library (http://sourceforge.net/apps/trac/pyusb/). +""" + +import sys +from time import sleep +import usb.core +import usb.util + +# Generic HID device VID, PID and report payload length (length is increased +# by one to account for the Report ID byte that must be pre-pended) +device_vid = 0x03EB +device_pid = 0x204F + +def get_and_init_hid_device(): + device = usb.core.find(idVendor=device_vid, idProduct=device_pid) + + if device is None: + sys.exit("Could not find USB device.") + + if device.is_kernel_driver_active(0): + try: + device.detach_kernel_driver(0) + except usb.core.USBError as exception: + sys.exit("Could not detatch kernel driver: %s" % str(exception)) + + try: + device.set_configuration() + except usb.core.USBError as exception: + sys.exit("Could not set configuration: %s" % str(exception)) + + return device + +def send_led_pattern(device, led1, led2, led3, led4): + # Report data for the demo is LED on/off data + report_data = [led1, led2, led3, led4] + + # Send the generated report to the device + number_of_bytes_written = device.ctrl_transfer( # Set Report control request + 0b00100001, # bmRequestType (constant for this control request) + 0x09, # bmRequest (constant for this control request) + 0, # wValue (MSB is report type, LSB is report number) + 0, # wIndex (interface number) + report_data # report data to be sent + ); + assert number_of_bytes_written == len(report_data) + + print("Sent LED Pattern: {0}".format(report_data)) + +def receive_led_pattern(hid_device): + endpoint = hid_device[0][(0,0)][0] + report_data = hid_device.read(endpoint.bEndpointAddress, endpoint.wMaxPacketSize) + return list(report_data) + +def main(): + hid_device = get_and_init_hid_device() + + print("Connected to device 0x%04X/0x%04X - %s [%s]" % + (hid_device.idVendor, hid_device.idProduct, + usb.util.get_string(hid_device, 256, hid_device.iProduct), + usb.util.get_string(hid_device, 256, hid_device.iManufacturer))) + + p = 0 + while (True): + # Convert the current pattern index to a bit-mask and send + send_led_pattern(hid_device, + (p >> 3) & 1, + (p >> 2) & 1, + (p >> 1) & 1, + (p >> 0) & 1) + + # Receive and print the current LED pattern + led_pattern = receive_led_pattern(hid_device)[0:4] + print("Received LED Pattern: {0}".format(led_pattern)) + + # Compute next LED pattern in sequence + p = (p + 1) % 16 + + # Delay a bit for visual effect + sleep(.2) + +if __name__ == '__main__': + main() diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/HostTestApp/test_generic_hid_winusb.py b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/HostTestApp/test_generic_hid_winusb.py new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1e5f430195 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/HostTestApp/test_generic_hid_winusb.py @@ -0,0 +1,96 @@ +""" + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +""" + +""" + LUFA Generic HID device demo host test script. This script will send a + continuous stream of generic reports to the device, to show a variable LED + pattern on the target board. Send and received report data is printed to + the terminal. + + Requires the pywinusb library (https://pypi.python.org/pypi/pywinusb/). +""" + +import sys +from time import sleep +import pywinusb.hid as hid + +# Generic HID device VID, PID and report payload length (length is increased +# by one to account for the Report ID byte that must be pre-pended) +device_vid = 0x03EB +device_pid = 0x204F +report_length = 1 + 8 + + +def get_hid_device_handle(): + hid_device_filter = hid.HidDeviceFilter(vendor_id=device_vid, + product_id=device_pid) + + valid_hid_devices = hid_device_filter.get_devices() + + if len(valid_hid_devices) is 0: + return None + else: + return valid_hid_devices[0] + + +def send_led_pattern(device, led1, led2, led3, led4): + # Report data for the demo is the report ID (always zero) followed by the + # LED on/off data + report_data = [0, led1, led2, led3, led4] + + # Zero-extend the array to the length the report should be + report_data.extend([0] * (report_length - len(report_data))) + + # Send the generated report to the device + device.send_output_report(report_data) + + print("Sent LED Pattern: {0}".format(report_data[1:5])) + + +def received_led_pattern(report_data): + print("Received LED Pattern: {0}".format(report_data[1:5])) + + +def main(): + hid_device = get_hid_device_handle() + + if hid_device is None: + print("No valid HID device found.") + sys.exit(1) + + try: + hid_device.open() + + print("Connected to device 0x%04X/0x%04X - %s [%s]" % + (hid_device.vendor_id, hid_device.product_id, + hid_device.product_name, hid_device.vendor_name)) + + # Set up the HID input report handler to receive reports + hid_device.set_raw_data_handler(received_led_pattern) + + p = 0 + while (hid_device.is_plugged()): + # Convert the current pattern index to a bit-mask and send + send_led_pattern(hid_device, + (p >> 3) & 1, + (p >> 2) & 1, + (p >> 1) & 1, + (p >> 0) & 1) + + # Compute next LED pattern in sequence + p = (p + 1) % 16 + + # Delay a bit for visual effect + sleep(.2) + + finally: + hid_device.close() + + +if __name__ == '__main__': + main() diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..710f7c719d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,63 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Generic HID Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.generic_hid.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.generic_hid"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Generic HID Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.generic_hid.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.generic_hid"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.class.generic_hid" caption="Generic HID Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Generic HID device demo, implementing a device whose LEDs can be controlled via HID messages from the host. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="GenericHID.txt"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="directory" value="HostTestApp"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="GenericHID.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="GenericHID.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ffc0d05905 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2396 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Generic HID Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ \ + HostTestApp/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..62fa2136a5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/GenericHID/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = GenericHID +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..299d2ec852 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 1 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4364cafa45 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,220 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the + * USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This + * descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding) + * the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for + * more details on HID report descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t PROGMEM JoystickReport[] = +{ + /* Use the HID class driver's standard Joystick report. + * Min X/Y/Z Axis values: -100 + * Max X/Y/Z Axis values: 100 + * Min physical X/Y/Z Axis values (used to determine resolution): -1 + * Max physical X/Y/Z Axis values (used to determine resolution): 1 + * Buttons: 2 + */ + HID_DESCRIPTOR_JOYSTICK(-100, 100, -1, 1, 2) +}; + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2043, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .HID_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Joystick, + .AlternateSetting = 0x00, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_NonBootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_NonBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID_JoystickHID = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(JoystickReport) + }, + + .HID_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = JOYSTICK_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = JOYSTICK_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Joystick Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + case HID_DTYPE_HID: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID_JoystickHID; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + break; + case HID_DTYPE_Report: + Address = &JoystickReport; + Size = sizeof(JoystickReport); + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9de556268c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Joystick HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID_Interface; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID_JoystickHID; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID_ReportINEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_Joystick = 0, /**< Joystick interface desciptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Joystick HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define JOYSTICK_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Size in bytes of the Joystick HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define JOYSTICK_EPSIZE 8 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/Joystick.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/Joystick.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d1f40ec0d7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/Joystick.c @@ -0,0 +1,202 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the Joystick demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "Joystick.h" + +/** Buffer to hold the previously generated HID report, for comparison purposes inside the HID class driver. */ +static uint8_t PrevJoystickHIDReportBuffer[sizeof(USB_JoystickReport_Data_t)]; + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t Joystick_HID_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Joystick, + .ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Address = JOYSTICK_EPADDR, + .Size = JOYSTICK_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .PrevReportINBuffer = PrevJoystickHIDReportBuffer, + .PrevReportINBufferSize = sizeof(PrevJoystickHIDReportBuffer), + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + HID_Device_USBTask(&Joystick_HID_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Joystick_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + Buttons_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= HID_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Joystick_HID_Interface); + + USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + HID_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Joystick_HID_Interface); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB device Start Of Frame event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void) +{ + HID_Device_MillisecondElapsed(&Joystick_HID_Interface); +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the creation of HID reports to the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in,out] ReportID Report ID requested by the host if non-zero, otherwise callback should set to the generated report ID + * \param[in] ReportType Type of the report to create, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_In or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[out] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the created report should be stored + * \param[out] ReportSize Number of bytes written in the report (or zero if no report is to be sent) + * + * \return Boolean \c true to force the sending of the report, \c false to let the library determine if it needs to be sent + */ +bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize) +{ + USB_JoystickReport_Data_t* JoystickReport = (USB_JoystickReport_Data_t*)ReportData; + + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + uint8_t ButtonStatus_LCL = Buttons_GetStatus(); + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + JoystickReport->Y = -100; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + JoystickReport->Y = 100; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + JoystickReport->X = -100; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + JoystickReport->X = 100; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + JoystickReport->Button |= (1 << 1); + + if (ButtonStatus_LCL & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) + JoystickReport->Button |= (1 << 0); + + *ReportSize = sizeof(USB_JoystickReport_Data_t); + return false; +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the processing of HID reports from the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in] ReportID Report ID of the received report from the host + * \param[in] ReportType The type of report that the host has sent, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_Out or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[in] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the received report has been stored + * \param[in] ReportSize Size in bytes of the received HID report + */ +void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize) +{ + // Unused (but mandatory for the HID class driver) in this demo, since there are no Host->Device reports +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/Joystick.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/Joystick.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e6e61bc1bc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/Joystick.h @@ -0,0 +1,100 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Joystick.c. + */ + +#ifndef _JOYSTICK_H_ +#define _JOYSTICK_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the joystick HID report structure, for creating and sending HID reports to the host PC. + * This mirrors the layout described to the host in the HID report descriptor, in Descriptors.c. + */ + typedef struct + { + int8_t X; /**< Current absolute joystick X position, as a signed 8-bit integer */ + int8_t Y; /**< Current absolute joystick Y position, as a signed 8-bit integer */ + int8_t Z; /**< Current absolute joystick Z position, as a signed 8-bit integer */ + uint8_t Button; /**< Bit mask of the currently pressed joystick buttons */ + } USB_JoystickReport_Data_t; + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void); + + bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize); + void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/Joystick.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/Joystick.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b174642f4c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/Joystick.txt @@ -0,0 +1,77 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Joystick Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Joystick demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Keyboard device, for USB Joysticks + * using the standard Keyboard HID profile. + * + * This device will show up as a generic joystick device, with two buttons. + * Pressing the joystick inwards is the first button, and the HWB button + * is the second. + * + * Moving the joystick on the selected board moves the joystick location on + * the host computer. + * + * Currently only single interface joysticks are supported. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..97d37a5aaf --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Joystick HID Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.joystick.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.joystick"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Joystick HID Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.joystick.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.joystick"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.class.joystick" caption="Joystick HID Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Joystick HID device demo, implementing a basic USB joystick that can send movement information to the host. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="Joystick.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Joystick.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Joystick.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..45ebd1341a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Joystick Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b6f6e2e2ae --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Joystick/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = Joystick +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..299d2ec852 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 1 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4a1e1297bf --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,216 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the + * USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This + * descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding) + * the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for + * more details on HID report descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t PROGMEM KeyboardReport[] = +{ + /* Use the HID class driver's standard Keyboard report. + * Max simultaneous keys: 6 + */ + HID_DESCRIPTOR_KEYBOARD(6) +}; + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2042, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .HID_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard, + .AlternateSetting = 0x00, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_BootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_KeyboardBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID_KeyboardHID = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(KeyboardReport) + }, + + .HID_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = KEYBOARD_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = KEYBOARD_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Keyboard Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + case HID_DTYPE_HID: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID_KeyboardHID; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + break; + case HID_DTYPE_Report: + Address = &KeyboardReport; + Size = sizeof(KeyboardReport); + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3e6a021da0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Keyboard HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID_Interface; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID_KeyboardHID; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID_ReportINEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard = 0, /**< Keyboard interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Keyboard HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define KEYBOARD_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Size in bytes of the Keyboard HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define KEYBOARD_EPSIZE 8 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/Keyboard.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/Keyboard.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..99799f6d53 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/Keyboard.c @@ -0,0 +1,219 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the Keyboard demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "Keyboard.h" + +/** Buffer to hold the previously generated Keyboard HID report, for comparison purposes inside the HID class driver. */ +static uint8_t PrevKeyboardHIDReportBuffer[sizeof(USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t)]; + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t Keyboard_HID_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard, + .ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Address = KEYBOARD_EPADDR, + .Size = KEYBOARD_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .PrevReportINBuffer = PrevKeyboardHIDReportBuffer, + .PrevReportINBufferSize = sizeof(PrevKeyboardHIDReportBuffer), + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + HID_Device_USBTask(&Keyboard_HID_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware() +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Joystick_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + Buttons_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= HID_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Keyboard_HID_Interface); + + USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + HID_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Keyboard_HID_Interface); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB device Start Of Frame event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void) +{ + HID_Device_MillisecondElapsed(&Keyboard_HID_Interface); +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the creation of HID reports to the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in,out] ReportID Report ID requested by the host if non-zero, otherwise callback should set to the generated report ID + * \param[in] ReportType Type of the report to create, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_In or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[out] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the created report should be stored + * \param[out] ReportSize Number of bytes written in the report (or zero if no report is to be sent) + * + * \return Boolean \c true to force the sending of the report, \c false to let the library determine if it needs to be sent + */ +bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize) +{ + USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t* KeyboardReport = (USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t*)ReportData; + + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + uint8_t ButtonStatus_LCL = Buttons_GetStatus(); + + uint8_t UsedKeyCodes = 0; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[UsedKeyCodes++] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_A; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[UsedKeyCodes++] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_B; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[UsedKeyCodes++] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_C; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[UsedKeyCodes++] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_D; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[UsedKeyCodes++] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_E; + + if (ButtonStatus_LCL & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[UsedKeyCodes++] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F; + + if (UsedKeyCodes) + KeyboardReport->Modifier = HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFIER_LEFTSHIFT; + + *ReportSize = sizeof(USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t); + return false; +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the processing of HID reports from the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in] ReportID Report ID of the received report from the host + * \param[in] ReportType The type of report that the host has sent, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_Out or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[in] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the received report has been stored + * \param[in] ReportSize Size in bytes of the received HID report + */ +void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize) +{ + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS; + uint8_t* LEDReport = (uint8_t*)ReportData; + + if (*LEDReport & HID_KEYBOARD_LED_NUMLOCK) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED1; + + if (*LEDReport & HID_KEYBOARD_LED_CAPSLOCK) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED3; + + if (*LEDReport & HID_KEYBOARD_LED_SCROLLLOCK) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED4; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/Keyboard.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/Keyboard.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..45d7423303 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/Keyboard.h @@ -0,0 +1,89 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Keyboard.c. + */ + +#ifndef _KEYBOARD_H_ +#define _KEYBOARD_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void); + + bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize); + void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/Keyboard.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/Keyboard.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3813745c8c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/Keyboard.txt @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Keyboard Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Keyboard Subclass</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Keyboard demonstration application. This gives a simple reference application + * for implementing a USB Keyboard using the basic USB HID drivers in all modern + * OSes (i.e. no special drivers required). It is boot protocol compatible, and thus + * works under compatible BIOS as if it was a native keyboard (e.g. PS/2). + * + * On start-up the system will automatically enumerate and function as a keyboard + * when the USB connection to a host is present. To use the keyboard example, + * manipulate the joystick to send the letters a, b, c, d and e. See the USB HID + * documentation for more information on sending keyboard event and key presses. Unlike + * other LUFA Keyboard demos, this example shows explicitly how to send multiple key presses + * inside the same report to the host. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d7cdc17bcc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Keyboard HID Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.keyboard.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.keyboard"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Keyboard HID Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.keyboard.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.keyboard"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.class.keyboard" caption="Keyboard HID Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Keyboard HID device demo, implementing a basic USB keyboard that can send key press information to the host. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="Keyboard.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Keyboard.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Keyboard.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e397319372 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Keyboard Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a02c41c644 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Keyboard/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = Keyboard +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cc828a108d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 3 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7a810ca5eb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,289 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the + * USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This + * descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding) + * the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for + * more details on HID report descriptors. + * + * This descriptor describes the mouse HID interface's report structure. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t PROGMEM MouseReport[] = +{ + /* Use the HID class driver's standard Mouse report. + * Min X/Y Axis values: -1 + * Max X/Y Axis values: 1 + * Min physical X/Y Axis values (used to determine resolution): -1 + * Max physical X/Y Axis values (used to determine resolution): 1 + * Buttons: 3 + * Absolute screen coordinates: false + */ + HID_DESCRIPTOR_MOUSE(-1, 1, -1, 1, 3, false) +}; + +/** Same as the MouseReport structure, but defines the keyboard HID interface's report structure. */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t PROGMEM KeyboardReport[] = +{ + /* Use the HID class driver's standard Keyboard report. + * Max simultaneous keys: 6 + */ + HID_DESCRIPTOR_KEYBOARD(6) +}; + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x204D, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .HID1_KeyboardInterface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard, + .AlternateSetting = 0x00, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_BootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_KeyboardBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID1_KeyboardHID = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(KeyboardReport) + }, + + .HID1_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = KEYBOARD_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = HID_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .HID2_MouseInterface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Mouse, + .AlternateSetting = 0x00, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_BootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_MouseBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID2_MouseHID = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(MouseReport) + }, + + .HID2_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MOUSE_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = HID_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Mouse and Keyboard Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + case HID_DTYPE_HID: + switch (wIndex) + { + case INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID1_KeyboardHID; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + break; + case INTERFACE_ID_Mouse: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID2_MouseHID; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + break; + } + + break; + case HID_DTYPE_Report: + switch (wIndex) + { + case INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard: + Address = &KeyboardReport; + Size = sizeof(KeyboardReport); + break; + case INTERFACE_ID_Mouse: + Address = &MouseReport; + Size = sizeof(MouseReport); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1baaa3c02c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,102 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Keyboard HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID1_KeyboardInterface; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID1_KeyboardHID; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID1_ReportINEndpoint; + + // Mouse HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID2_MouseInterface; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID2_MouseHID; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID2_ReportINEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard = 0, /**< Keyboard interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_Mouse = 1, /**< Mouse interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Keyboard HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define KEYBOARD_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Endpoint address of the Mouse HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define MOUSE_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Size in bytes of each of the HID reporting IN endpoints. */ + #define HID_EPSIZE 8 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4405fe745e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.c @@ -0,0 +1,276 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the KeyboardMouse demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "KeyboardMouse.h" + +/** Buffer to hold the previously generated Keyboard HID report, for comparison purposes inside the HID class driver. */ +static uint8_t PrevKeyboardHIDReportBuffer[sizeof(USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t)]; + +/** Buffer to hold the previously generated Mouse HID report, for comparison purposes inside the HID class driver. */ +static uint8_t PrevMouseHIDReportBuffer[sizeof(USB_MouseReport_Data_t)]; + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. This is for the keyboard HID + * interface within the device. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t Keyboard_HID_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard, + .ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Address = KEYBOARD_IN_EPADDR, + .Size = HID_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .PrevReportINBuffer = PrevKeyboardHIDReportBuffer, + .PrevReportINBufferSize = sizeof(PrevKeyboardHIDReportBuffer), + }, + }; + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. This is for the mouse HID + * interface within the device. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t Mouse_HID_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Mouse, + .ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Address = MOUSE_IN_EPADDR, + .Size = HID_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .PrevReportINBuffer = PrevMouseHIDReportBuffer, + .PrevReportINBufferSize = sizeof(PrevMouseHIDReportBuffer), + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + HID_Device_USBTask(&Keyboard_HID_Interface); + HID_Device_USBTask(&Mouse_HID_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware() +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Joystick_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= HID_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Keyboard_HID_Interface); + ConfigSuccess &= HID_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Mouse_HID_Interface); + + USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + HID_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Keyboard_HID_Interface); + HID_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Mouse_HID_Interface); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB device Start Of Frame event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void) +{ + HID_Device_MillisecondElapsed(&Keyboard_HID_Interface); + HID_Device_MillisecondElapsed(&Mouse_HID_Interface); +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the creation of HID reports to the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in,out] ReportID Report ID requested by the host if non-zero, otherwise callback should set to the generated report ID + * \param[in] ReportType Type of the report to create, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_In or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[out] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the created report should be stored + * \param[out] ReportSize Number of bytes written in the report (or zero if no report is to be sent) + * + * \return Boolean \c true to force the sending of the report, \c false to let the library determine if it needs to be sent + */ +bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize) +{ + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + uint8_t ButtonStatus_LCL = Buttons_GetStatus(); + + /* Determine which interface must have its report generated */ + if (HIDInterfaceInfo == &Keyboard_HID_Interface) + { + USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t* KeyboardReport = (USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t*)ReportData; + + /* If first board button not being held down, no keyboard report */ + if (!(ButtonStatus_LCL & BUTTONS_BUTTON1)) + return 0; + + KeyboardReport->Modifier = HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFIER_LEFTSHIFT; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_A; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_B; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_C; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_D; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_E; + + *ReportSize = sizeof(USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t); + return false; + } + else + { + USB_MouseReport_Data_t* MouseReport = (USB_MouseReport_Data_t*)ReportData; + + /* If first board button being held down, no mouse report */ + if (ButtonStatus_LCL & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) + return 0; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + MouseReport->Y = -1; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + MouseReport->Y = 1; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + MouseReport->X = -1; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + MouseReport->X = 1; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + MouseReport->Button |= (1 << 0); + + *ReportSize = sizeof(USB_MouseReport_Data_t); + return true; + } +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the processing of HID reports from the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in] ReportID Report ID of the received report from the host + * \param[in] ReportType The type of report that the host has sent, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_Out or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[in] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the received report has been stored + * \param[in] ReportSize Size in bytes of the received HID report + */ +void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize) +{ + if (HIDInterfaceInfo == &Keyboard_HID_Interface) + { + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS; + uint8_t* LEDReport = (uint8_t*)ReportData; + + if (*LEDReport & HID_KEYBOARD_LED_NUMLOCK) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED1; + + if (*LEDReport & HID_KEYBOARD_LED_CAPSLOCK) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED3; + + if (*LEDReport & HID_KEYBOARD_LED_SCROLLLOCK) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED4; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dba805d6a5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.h @@ -0,0 +1,84 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#ifndef _KEYBOARD_MOUSE_H_ +#define _KEYBOARD_MOUSE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void); + + bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize); + void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..262a84f0ed --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.txt @@ -0,0 +1,81 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Dual HID Keyboard and Mouse Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Keyboard/Mouse demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a composite device containing both USB Keyboard + * and USB Mouse functionality using the basic USB HID drivers in all modern OSes + * (i.e. no special drivers required). This example uses two separate HID + * interfaces for each function. It is boot protocol compatible, and thus works under + * compatible BIOS as if it was a native keyboard and mouse (e.g. PS/2). + * + * On start-up the system will automatically enumerate and function + * as a keyboard when the USB connection to a host is present and the HWB is not + * pressed. When enabled, manipulate the joystick to send the letters + * a, b, c, d and e. See the USB HID documentation for more information + * on sending keyboard event and key presses. + * + * When the HWB is pressed, the mouse mode is enabled. When enabled, move the + * joystick to move the pointer, and push the joystick inwards to simulate a + * left-button click. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4b5ca01214 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Keyboard and Mouse HID Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.keyboard_mouse.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.keyboard_mouse"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Keyboard and Mouse HID Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.keyboard_mouse.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.keyboard_mouse"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.class.keyboard_mouse" caption="Keyboard and Mouse HID Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Keyboard and Mouse HID device demo, implementing a basic USB keyboard and mouse using a pair of HID interfaces. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="KeyboardMouse.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="KeyboardMouse.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="KeyboardMouse.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6648a78d11 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Combined Keyboard/Mouse Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e4eddb7368 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouse/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = KeyboardMouse +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..299d2ec852 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 1 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..af1d5380b6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,279 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the + * USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This + * descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding) + * the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for + * more details on HID report descriptors. + * + * This descriptor describes the multiple possible reports of the HID interface's report structure. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t PROGMEM HIDReport[] = +{ + /* Mouse Report */ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x01), /* Generic Desktop */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x02), /* Mouse */ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x01), /* Application */ + HID_RI_REPORT_ID(8, HID_REPORTID_MouseReport), + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x01), /* Pointer */ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x00), /* Physical */ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x09), /* Button */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(8, 0x03), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x03), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x05), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_CONSTANT), + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x01), /* Generic Desktop */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x30), /* Usage X */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x31), /* Usage Y */ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, -1), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 1), + HID_RI_PHYSICAL_MINIMUM(8, -1), + HID_RI_PHYSICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 1), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x02), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x08), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_RELATIVE), + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0), + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0), + + /* Keyboard Report */ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x01), /* Generic Desktop */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x06), /* Keyboard */ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x01), /* Application */ + HID_RI_REPORT_ID(8, HID_REPORTID_KeyboardReport), + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x07), /* Key Codes */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(8, 0xE0), /* Keyboard Left Control */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(8, 0xE7), /* Keyboard Right GUI */ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x08), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x08), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_CONSTANT), + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x08), /* LEDs */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(8, 0x01), /* Num Lock */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(8, 0x05), /* Kana */ + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x05), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_OUTPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE | HID_IOF_NON_VOLATILE), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x03), + HID_RI_OUTPUT(8, HID_IOF_CONSTANT), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 0x65), + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x07), /* Keyboard */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), /* Reserved (no event indicated) */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(8, 0x65), /* Keyboard Application */ + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x06), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x08), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_ARRAY | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE), + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0), +}; + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2066, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .HID_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_KeyboardAndMouse, + .AlternateSetting = 0x00, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_NonBootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_NonBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID_HIDData = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(HIDReport) + }, + + .HID_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = HID_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = HID_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Multi HID Report Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + case HID_DTYPE_HID: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID_HIDData; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + break; + case HID_DTYPE_Report: + Address = &HIDReport; + Size = sizeof(HIDReport); + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..aaaf550c8a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,101 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Combined Keyboard/Mouse HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID_Interface; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID_HIDData; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID_ReportINEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_KeyboardAndMouse = 0, /**< Combined keyboard and mouse interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define HID_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Size in bytes of each of the HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define HID_EPSIZE 8 + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the HID report IDs used in the device. */ + enum + { + HID_REPORTID_MouseReport = 0x01, /**< Report ID for the Mouse report within the device. */ + HID_REPORTID_KeyboardReport = 0x02, /**< Report ID for the Keyboard report within the device. */ + } HID_Report_IDs; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/KeyboardMouseMultiReport.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/KeyboardMouseMultiReport.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c49124974e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/KeyboardMouseMultiReport.c @@ -0,0 +1,237 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the KeyboardMouseMultiReport demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "KeyboardMouseMultiReport.h" + +/** Buffer to hold the previously generated HID report, for comparison purposes inside the HID class driver. */ +static uint8_t PrevHIDReportBuffer[MAX(sizeof(USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t), sizeof(USB_MouseReport_Data_t))]; + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t Device_HID_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_KeyboardAndMouse, + .ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Address = HID_IN_EPADDR, + .Size = HID_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .PrevReportINBuffer = PrevHIDReportBuffer, + .PrevReportINBufferSize = sizeof(PrevHIDReportBuffer), + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + HID_Device_USBTask(&Device_HID_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware() +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Joystick_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= HID_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Device_HID_Interface); + + USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + HID_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Device_HID_Interface); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB device Start Of Frame event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void) +{ + HID_Device_MillisecondElapsed(&Device_HID_Interface); +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the creation of HID reports to the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in,out] ReportID Report ID requested by the host if non-zero, otherwise callback should set to the generated report ID + * \param[in] ReportType Type of the report to create, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_In or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[out] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the created report should be stored + * \param[out] ReportSize Number of bytes written in the report (or zero if no report is to be sent) + * + * \return Boolean \c true to force the sending of the report, \c false to let the library determine if it needs to be sent + */ +bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize) +{ + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + uint8_t ButtonStatus_LCL = Buttons_GetStatus(); + + if (!(ButtonStatus_LCL & BUTTONS_BUTTON1)) + { + USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t* KeyboardReport = (USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t*)ReportData; + + KeyboardReport->Modifier = HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFIER_LEFTSHIFT; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_A; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_B; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_C; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_D; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_E; + + *ReportID = HID_REPORTID_KeyboardReport; + *ReportSize = sizeof(USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t); + return false; + } + else + { + USB_MouseReport_Data_t* MouseReport = (USB_MouseReport_Data_t*)ReportData; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + MouseReport->Y = -1; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + MouseReport->Y = 1; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + MouseReport->X = -1; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + MouseReport->X = 1; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + MouseReport->Button |= (1 << 0); + + *ReportID = HID_REPORTID_MouseReport; + *ReportSize = sizeof(USB_MouseReport_Data_t); + return true; + } +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the processing of HID reports from the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in] ReportID Report ID of the received report from the host + * \param[in] ReportType The type of report that the host has sent, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_Out or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[in] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the received report has been stored + * \param[in] ReportSize Size in bytes of the received HID report + */ +void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize) +{ + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS; + uint8_t* LEDReport = (uint8_t*)ReportData; + + if (*LEDReport & HID_KEYBOARD_LED_NUMLOCK) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED1; + + if (*LEDReport & HID_KEYBOARD_LED_CAPSLOCK) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED3; + + if (*LEDReport & HID_KEYBOARD_LED_SCROLLLOCK) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED4; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/KeyboardMouseMultiReport.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/KeyboardMouseMultiReport.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dba805d6a5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/KeyboardMouseMultiReport.h @@ -0,0 +1,84 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#ifndef _KEYBOARD_MOUSE_H_ +#define _KEYBOARD_MOUSE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void); + + bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize); + void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/KeyboardMouseMultiReport.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/KeyboardMouseMultiReport.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ed55f595a0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/KeyboardMouseMultiReport.txt @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Multiple Report HID Keyboard and Mouse Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Keyboard/Mouse demonstration application, using a single HID interface. This gives + * a simple reference application for implementing a multiple HID report device + * containing both USB Keyboard and USB Mouse functionality using the basic USB HID + * drivers in all modern OSes (i.e. no special drivers required). This example uses a + * single HID interface that is shared between the two functions. + * + * On start-up the system will automatically enumerate and function as a keyboard when + * the USB connection to a host is present and the HWB is not pressed. When enabled, + * manipulate the joystick to send the letters a, b, c, d and e. See the USB HID + * documentation for more information on sending keyboard event and key presses. + * + * When the HWB is pressed, the mouse mode is enabled. When enabled, move the joystick + * to move the pointer, and push the joystick inwards to simulate a left-button click. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..39487fd8a7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,61 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Keyboard and Mouse HID (Multi Report) Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.keyboard_mouse_mr.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.keyboard_mouse_mr"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Keyboard and Mouse HID (Multi Report) Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.keyboard_mouse_mr.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.keyboard_mouse_mr"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.class.keyboard_mouse_mr" caption="Keyboard and Mouse HID (Multi Report) Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Keyboard and Mouse HID device demo, implementing a basic USB keyboard and mouse using a single HID interface and multiple logical reports. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="KeyboardMouseMultiReport.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="KeyboardMouseMultiReport.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="KeyboardMouseMultiReport.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6ea750cfc7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Combined Keyboard/Mouse (Multiple HID Report) Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..22957f87d0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/KeyboardMouseMultiReport/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = KeyboardMouseMultiReport +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..00eefc7bf7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 2 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b4bcea1ee7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,314 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2048, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .Audio_ControlInterface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioControl, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 0, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_ControlSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_ControlProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_ControlInterface_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .ACSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,0,0), + .TotalLength = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t), + + .InCollection = 1, + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_MIDIStreamingSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_StreamingProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_AudioInterface_AS_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_General, + + .AudioSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,0,0), + + .TotalLength = (sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t) - + offsetof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t, Audio_StreamInterface_SPC)) + }, + + .MIDI_In_Jack_Emb = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_InputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_Embedded, + .JackID = 0x01, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_In_Jack_Ext = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_InputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_External, + .JackID = 0x02, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_Out_Jack_Emb = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_OutputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_Embedded, + .JackID = 0x03, + + .NumberOfPins = 1, + .SourceJackID = {0x02}, + .SourcePinID = {0x01}, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_Out_Jack_Ext = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_OutputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_External, + .JackID = 0x04, + + .NumberOfPins = 1, + .SourceJackID = {0x01}, + .SourcePinID = {0x01}, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_In_Jack_Endpoint = + { + .Endpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MIDI_STREAM_OUT_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .Refresh = 0, + .SyncEndpointNumber = 0 + }, + + .MIDI_In_Jack_Endpoint_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_Jack_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSEndpoint}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSEndpoint_General, + + .TotalEmbeddedJacks = 0x01, + .AssociatedJackID = {0x01} + }, + + .MIDI_Out_Jack_Endpoint = + { + .Endpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MIDI_STREAM_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .Refresh = 0, + .SyncEndpointNumber = 0 + }, + + .MIDI_Out_Jack_Endpoint_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_Jack_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSEndpoint}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSEndpoint_General, + + .TotalEmbeddedJacks = 0x01, + .AssociatedJackID = {0x03} + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA MIDI Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..44737d7c41 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,108 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the MIDI streaming data IN endpoint, for device-to-host data transfers. */ + #define MIDI_STREAM_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 2) + + /** Endpoint address of the MIDI streaming data OUT endpoint, for host-to-device data transfers. */ + #define MIDI_STREAM_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 1) + + /** Endpoint size in bytes of the Audio isochronous streaming data IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE 64 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // MIDI Audio Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_ControlInterface; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t Audio_ControlInterface_SPC; + + // MIDI Audio Streaming Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_StreamInterface; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_AudioInterface_AS_t Audio_StreamInterface_SPC; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t MIDI_In_Jack_Emb; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t MIDI_In_Jack_Ext; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t MIDI_Out_Jack_Emb; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t MIDI_Out_Jack_Ext; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t MIDI_In_Jack_Endpoint; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_Jack_Endpoint_t MIDI_In_Jack_Endpoint_SPC; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t MIDI_Out_Jack_Endpoint; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_Jack_Endpoint_t MIDI_Out_Jack_Endpoint_SPC; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_AudioControl = 0, /**< Audio control interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream = 1, /**< Audio streaming interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/MIDI.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/MIDI.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d52542234a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/MIDI.c @@ -0,0 +1,211 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the MIDI demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "MIDI.h" + +/** LUFA MIDI Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all MIDI Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Device_t Keyboard_MIDI_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .StreamingInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = MIDI_STREAM_IN_EPADDR, + .Size = MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = MIDI_STREAM_OUT_EPADDR, + .Size = MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + CheckJoystickMovement(); + + MIDI_EventPacket_t ReceivedMIDIEvent; + while (MIDI_Device_ReceiveEventPacket(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface, &ReceivedMIDIEvent)) + { + if ((ReceivedMIDIEvent.Event == MIDI_EVENT(0, MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON)) && (ReceivedMIDIEvent.Data3 > 0)) + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ReceivedMIDIEvent.Data2 > 64 ? LEDS_LED1 : LEDS_LED2); + else + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDS_NO_LEDS); + } + + MIDI_Device_USBTask(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Joystick_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + Buttons_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Checks for changes in the position of the board joystick, sending MIDI events to the host upon each change. */ +void CheckJoystickMovement(void) +{ + static uint8_t PrevJoystickStatus; + + uint8_t MIDICommand = 0; + uint8_t MIDIPitch; + + /* Get current joystick mask, XOR with previous to detect joystick changes */ + uint8_t JoystickStatus = Joystick_GetStatus(); + uint8_t JoystickChanges = (JoystickStatus ^ PrevJoystickStatus); + + /* Get board button status - if pressed use channel 10 (percussion), otherwise use channel 1 */ + uint8_t Channel = ((Buttons_GetStatus() & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ? MIDI_CHANNEL(10) : MIDI_CHANNEL(1)); + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_LEFT) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_LEFT)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3C; + } + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_UP) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_UP)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3D; + } + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_RIGHT) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_RIGHT)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3E; + } + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_DOWN) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_DOWN)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3F; + } + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_PRESS) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_PRESS)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3B; + } + + if (MIDICommand) + { + MIDI_EventPacket_t MIDIEvent = (MIDI_EventPacket_t) + { + .Event = MIDI_EVENT(0, MIDICommand), + + .Data1 = MIDICommand | Channel, + .Data2 = MIDIPitch, + .Data3 = MIDI_STANDARD_VELOCITY, + }; + + MIDI_Device_SendEventPacket(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface, &MIDIEvent); + MIDI_Device_Flush(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface); + } + + PrevJoystickStatus = JoystickStatus; +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= MIDI_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + MIDI_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/MIDI.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/MIDI.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c59b4253d6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/MIDI.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for MIDI.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MIDI_H_ +#define _MIDI_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void CheckJoystickMovement(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/MIDI.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/MIDI.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..97a92a1907 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/MIDI.txt @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage MIDI Input Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Audio Class</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Standard Audio Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Audio Class Specification \n + * USB-MIDI Audio Class Extension Specification \n + * General MIDI Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * MIDI demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing the USB-MIDI class in USB devices. + * It is built upon the USB Audio class. + * + * Joystick movements are translated into note on/off messages and + * are sent to the host PC as MIDI streams which can be read by any + * MIDI program supporting MIDI IN devices. + * + * If the HWB is not pressed, channel 1 (default piano) is used. If + * the HWB is pressed, then channel 10 (default percussion) is selected. + * + * This device implements MIDI-THRU mode, with the IN MIDI data being + * generated by the device itself. OUT MIDI data is discarded. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..33a4fd5830 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="MIDI Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.midi.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.midi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="MIDI Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.midi.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.midi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.class.midi" caption="MIDI Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ MIDI device demo, implementing a basic USB MIDI device that can send messages to the host. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="MIDI Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="MIDI.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="MIDI.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="MIDI.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e7bfea0c02 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - MIDI Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f030a1e724 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MIDI/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = MIDI +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b18b2c4149 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define TOTAL_LUNS 1 + + #define DISK_READ_ONLY false + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0ec4635eb0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 4 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..115a7482c4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,194 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2045, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED, + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .MS_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = MS_CSCP_MassStorageClass, + .SubClass = MS_CSCP_SCSITransparentSubclass, + .Protocol = MS_CSCP_BulkOnlyTransportProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MS_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .MS_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Mass Storage Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1124deb643 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,98 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Mass Storage device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the Mass Storage host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) + + /** Size in bytes of the Mass Storage data endpoints. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE 64 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Mass Storage Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t MS_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t MS_DataInEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t MS_DataOutEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage = 0, /**< Mass storage interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Lib/DataflashManager.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Lib/DataflashManager.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c0fd16ccc4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Lib/DataflashManager.c @@ -0,0 +1,534 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Functions to manage the physical Dataflash media, including reading and writing of + * blocks of data. These functions are called by the SCSI layer when data must be stored + * or retrieved to/from the physical storage media. If a different media is used (such + * as a SD card or EEPROM), functions similar to these will need to be generated. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_DATAFLASHMANAGER_C +#include "DataflashManager.h" + +/** Writes blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) to the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), from + * the pre-selected data OUT endpoint. This routine reads in OS sized blocks from the endpoint and writes + * them to the Dataflash in Dataflash page sized blocks. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Mass Storage Class configuration and state + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the write sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to write + */ +void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + bool UsingSecondBuffer = false; + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, CurrDFPageByte); + + /* Wait until endpoint is ready before continuing */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Write an endpoint packet sized data block to the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if the endpoint is currently empty */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + /* Clear the current endpoint bank */ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + /* Wait until the host has sent another packet */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + } + + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Once all the Dataflash ICs have had their first buffers filled, switch buffers to maintain throughput */ + if (Dataflash_GetSelectedChip() == DATAFLASH_CHIP_MASK(DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS)) + UsingSecondBuffer = !(UsingSecondBuffer); + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* If less than one Dataflash page remaining, copy over the existing page to preserve trailing data */ + if ((TotalBlocks * (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) < (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF2 : DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + } +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2WRITE : DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, 0); + } + + /* Write one 16-byte chunk of data to the Dataflash */ + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + + /* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ + if (MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset) + return; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0x00); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + + /* If the endpoint is empty, clear it ready for the next packet from the host */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Reads blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) from the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), into + * the pre-selected data IN endpoint. This routine reads in Dataflash page sized blocks from the Dataflash + * and writes them in OS sized blocks to the endpoint. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Mass Storage Class configuration and state + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the read sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to read + */ +void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, CurrDFPageByte); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + + /* Wait until endpoint is ready before continuing */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Read an endpoint packet sized data block from the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if the endpoint is currently full */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + /* Clear the endpoint bank to send its contents to the host */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Wait until the endpoint is ready for more data */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + } + + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + } + + /* Read one 16-byte chunk of data from the Dataflash */ + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + + /* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ + if (MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset) + return; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* If the endpoint is full, send its contents to the host */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Writes blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) to the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), from + * the given RAM buffer. This routine reads in OS sized blocks from the buffer and writes them to the + * Dataflash in Dataflash page sized blocks. This can be linked to FAT libraries to write files to the + * Dataflash. + * + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the write sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to write + * \param[in] BufferPtr Pointer to the data source RAM buffer + */ +void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + bool UsingSecondBuffer = false; + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, CurrDFPageByte); + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Write an endpoint packet sized data block to the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Once all the Dataflash ICs have had their first buffers filled, switch buffers to maintain throughput */ + if (Dataflash_GetSelectedChip() == DATAFLASH_CHIP_MASK(DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS)) + UsingSecondBuffer = !(UsingSecondBuffer); + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* If less than one Dataflash page remaining, copy over the existing page to preserve trailing data */ + if ((TotalBlocks * (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) < (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF2 : DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + } +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2WRITE : DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, 0); + } + + /* Write one 16-byte chunk of data to the Dataflash */ + for (uint8_t ByteNum = 0; ByteNum < 16; ByteNum++) + Dataflash_SendByte(*(BufferPtr++)); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0x00); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Reads blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) from the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), into + * the preallocated RAM buffer. This routine reads in Dataflash page sized blocks from the Dataflash + * and writes them in OS sized blocks to the given buffer. This can be linked to FAT libraries to read + * the files stored on the Dataflash. + * + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the read sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to read + * \param[out] BufferPtr Pointer to the data destination RAM buffer + */ +void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, CurrDFPageByte); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Read an endpoint packet sized data block from the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + } + + /* Read one 16-byte chunk of data from the Dataflash */ + for (uint8_t ByteNum = 0; ByteNum < 16; ByteNum++) + *(BufferPtr++) = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Disables the Dataflash memory write protection bits on the board Dataflash ICs, if enabled. */ +void DataflashManager_ResetDataflashProtections(void) +{ + /* Select first Dataflash chip, send the read status register command */ + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + + /* Check if sector protection is enabled */ + if (Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_SECTORPROTECTION_ON) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + + /* Send the commands to disable sector protection */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[0]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[1]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[2]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[3]); + } + + /* Select second Dataflash chip (if present on selected board), send read status register command */ + #if (DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS == 2) + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP2); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + + /* Check if sector protection is enabled */ + if (Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_SECTORPROTECTION_ON) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + + /* Send the commands to disable sector protection */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[0]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[1]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[2]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[3]); + } + #endif + + /* Deselect current Dataflash chip */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Performs a simple test on the attached Dataflash IC(s) to ensure that they are working. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if all media chips are working, \c false otherwise + */ +bool DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation(void) +{ + uint8_t ReturnByte; + + /* Test first Dataflash IC is present and responding to commands */ + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_READMANUFACTURERDEVICEINFO); + ReturnByte = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + /* If returned data is invalid, fail the command */ + if (ReturnByte != DF_MANUFACTURER_ATMEL) + return false; + + #if (DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS == 2) + /* Test second Dataflash IC is present and responding to commands */ + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP2); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_READMANUFACTURERDEVICEINFO); + ReturnByte = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + /* If returned data is invalid, fail the command */ + if (ReturnByte != DF_MANUFACTURER_ATMEL) + return false; + #endif + + return true; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Lib/DataflashManager.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Lib/DataflashManager.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b33f3f46d1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Lib/DataflashManager.h @@ -0,0 +1,89 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for DataflashManager.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DATAFLASH_MANAGER_H_ +#define _DATAFLASH_MANAGER_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + + #include "../MassStorage.h" + #include "../Descriptors.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h> + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE % 16) + #error Dataflash page size must be a multiple of 16 bytes. + #endif + + /* Defines: */ + /** Total number of bytes of the storage medium, comprised of one or more Dataflash ICs. */ + #define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES ((uint32_t)DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) + + /** Block size of the device. This is kept at 512 to remain compatible with the OS despite the underlying + * storage media (Dataflash) using a different native block size. Do not change this value. + */ + #define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE 512 + + /** Total number of blocks of the virtual memory for reporting to the host as the device's total capacity. Do not + * change this value; change VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES instead to alter the media size. + */ + #define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCKS (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES / VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + + /** Blocks in each LUN, calculated from the total capacity divided by the total number of Logical Units in the device. */ + #define LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCKS / TOTAL_LUNS) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks); + void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks); + void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + void DataflashManager_ResetDataflashProtections(void); + bool DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8780d1603d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.c @@ -0,0 +1,349 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * SCSI command processing routines, for SCSI commands issued by the host. Mass Storage + * devices use a thin "Bulk-Only Transport" protocol for issuing commands and status information, + * which wrap around standard SCSI device commands for controlling the actual storage medium. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_SCSI_C +#include "SCSI.h" + +/** Structure to hold the SCSI response data to a SCSI INQUIRY command. This gives information about the device's + * features and capabilities. + */ +static const SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t InquiryData = + { + .DeviceType = DEVICE_TYPE_BLOCK, + .PeripheralQualifier = 0, + + .Removable = true, + + .Version = 0, + + .ResponseDataFormat = 2, + .NormACA = false, + .TrmTsk = false, + .AERC = false, + + .AdditionalLength = 0x1F, + + .SoftReset = false, + .CmdQue = false, + .Linked = false, + .Sync = false, + .WideBus16Bit = false, + .WideBus32Bit = false, + .RelAddr = false, + + .VendorID = "LUFA", + .ProductID = "Dataflash Disk", + .RevisionID = {'0','.','0','0'}, + }; + +/** Structure to hold the sense data for the last issued SCSI command, which is returned to the host after a SCSI REQUEST SENSE + * command is issued. This gives information on exactly why the last command failed to complete. + */ +static SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t SenseData = + { + .ResponseCode = 0x70, + .AdditionalLength = 0x0A, + }; + + +/** Main routine to process the SCSI command located in the Command Block Wrapper read from the host. This dispatches + * to the appropriate SCSI command handling routine if the issued command is supported by the device, else it returns + * a command failure due to a ILLEGAL REQUEST. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise + */ +bool SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + bool CommandSuccess = false; + + /* Run the appropriate SCSI command hander function based on the passed command */ + switch (MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[0]) + { + case SCSI_CMD_INQUIRY: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Inquiry(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_REQUEST_SENSE: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_READ_CAPACITY_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_SEND_DIAGNOSTIC: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_WRITE_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(MSInterfaceInfo, DATA_WRITE); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_READ_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(MSInterfaceInfo, DATA_READ); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_MODE_SENSE_6: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_START_STOP_UNIT: + case SCSI_CMD_TEST_UNIT_READY: + case SCSI_CMD_PREVENT_ALLOW_MEDIUM_REMOVAL: + case SCSI_CMD_VERIFY_10: + /* These commands should just succeed, no handling required */ + CommandSuccess = true; + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength = 0; + break; + default: + /* Update the SENSE key to reflect the invalid command */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_COMMAND, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + break; + } + + /* Check if command was successfully processed */ + if (CommandSuccess) + { + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_GOOD, + SCSI_ASENSE_NO_ADDITIONAL_INFORMATION, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return true; + } + + return false; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI INQUIRY command. This command returns information about the device's features + * and capabilities to the host. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Inquiry(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint16_t AllocationLength = SwapEndian_16(*(uint16_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[3]); + uint16_t BytesTransferred = MIN(AllocationLength, sizeof(InquiryData)); + + /* Only the standard INQUIRY data is supported, check if any optional INQUIRY bits set */ + if ((MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[1] & ((1 << 0) | (1 << 1))) || + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[2]) + { + /* Optional but unsupported bits set - update the SENSE key and fail the request */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_FIELD_IN_CDB, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&InquiryData, BytesTransferred, NULL); + + /* Pad out remaining bytes with 0x00 */ + Endpoint_Null_Stream((AllocationLength - BytesTransferred), NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= BytesTransferred; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI REQUEST SENSE command. This command returns information about the last issued command, + * including the error code and additional error information so that the host can determine why a command failed to complete. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint8_t AllocationLength = MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[4]; + uint8_t BytesTransferred = MIN(AllocationLength, sizeof(SenseData)); + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&SenseData, BytesTransferred, NULL); + Endpoint_Null_Stream((AllocationLength - BytesTransferred), NULL); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= BytesTransferred; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI READ CAPACITY (10) command. This command returns information about the device's capacity + * on the selected Logical Unit (drive), as a number of OS-sized blocks. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint32_t LastBlockAddressInLUN = (LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS - 1); + uint32_t MediaBlockSize = VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE; + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE(&LastBlockAddressInLUN, sizeof(LastBlockAddressInLUN), NULL); + Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE(&MediaBlockSize, sizeof(MediaBlockSize), NULL); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= 8; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI SEND DIAGNOSTIC command. This command performs a quick check of the Dataflash ICs on the + * board, and indicates if they are present and functioning correctly. Only the Self-Test portion of the diagnostic command is + * supported. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + /* Check to see if the SELF TEST bit is not set */ + if (!(MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[1] & (1 << 2))) + { + /* Only self-test supported - update SENSE key and fail the command */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_FIELD_IN_CDB, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Check to see if all attached Dataflash ICs are functional */ + if (!(DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation())) + { + /* Update SENSE key with a hardware error condition and return command fail */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_HARDWARE_ERROR, + SCSI_ASENSE_NO_ADDITIONAL_INFORMATION, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength = 0; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI READ (10) or WRITE (10) command. This command reads in the block start address + * and total number of blocks to process, then calls the appropriate low-level Dataflash routine to handle the actual + * reading and writing of the data. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * \param[in] IsDataRead Indicates if the command is a READ (10) command or WRITE (10) command (DATA_READ or DATA_WRITE) + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const bool IsDataRead) +{ + uint32_t BlockAddress; + uint16_t TotalBlocks; + + /* Check if the disk is write protected or not */ + if ((IsDataRead == DATA_WRITE) && DISK_READ_ONLY) + { + /* Block address is invalid, update SENSE key and return command fail */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_DATA_PROTECT, + SCSI_ASENSE_WRITE_PROTECTED, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Load in the 32-bit block address (SCSI uses big-endian, so have to reverse the byte order) */ + BlockAddress = SwapEndian_32(*(uint32_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[2]); + + /* Load in the 16-bit total blocks (SCSI uses big-endian, so have to reverse the byte order) */ + TotalBlocks = SwapEndian_16(*(uint16_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[7]); + + /* Check if the block address is outside the maximum allowable value for the LUN */ + if (BlockAddress >= LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS) + { + /* Block address is invalid, update SENSE key and return command fail */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_LOGICAL_BLOCK_ADDRESS_OUT_OF_RANGE, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + #if (TOTAL_LUNS > 1) + /* Adjust the given block address to the real media address based on the selected LUN */ + BlockAddress += ((uint32_t)MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.LUN * LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS); + #endif + + /* Determine if the packet is a READ (10) or WRITE (10) command, call appropriate function */ + if (IsDataRead == DATA_READ) + DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(MSInterfaceInfo, BlockAddress, TotalBlocks); + else + DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(MSInterfaceInfo, BlockAddress, TotalBlocks); + + /* Update the bytes transferred counter and succeed the command */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= ((uint32_t)TotalBlocks * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE); + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI MODE SENSE (6) command. This command returns various informational pages about + * the SCSI device, as well as the device's Write Protect status. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + /* Send an empty header response with the Write Protect flag status */ + Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); + Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); + Endpoint_Write_8(DISK_READ_ONLY ? 0x80 : 0x00); + Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Update the bytes transferred counter and succeed the command */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= 4; + + return true; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..16eb78aa12 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.h @@ -0,0 +1,89 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for SCSI.c. + */ + +#ifndef _SCSI_H_ +#define _SCSI_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "../MassStorage.h" + #include "../Descriptors.h" + #include "DataflashManager.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Macro to set the current SCSI sense data to the given key, additional sense code and additional sense qualifier. This + * is for convenience, as it allows for all three sense values (returned upon request to the host to give information about + * the last command failure) in a quick and easy manner. + * + * \param[in] Key New SCSI sense key to set the sense code to + * \param[in] Acode New SCSI additional sense key to set the additional sense code to + * \param[in] Aqual New SCSI additional sense key qualifier to set the additional sense qualifier code to + */ + #define SCSI_SET_SENSE(Key, Acode, Aqual) do { SenseData.SenseKey = (Key); \ + SenseData.AdditionalSenseCode = (Acode); \ + SenseData.AdditionalSenseQualifier = (Aqual); } while (0) + + /** Macro for the \ref SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10() function, to indicate that data is to be read from the storage medium. */ + #define DATA_READ true + + /** Macro for the \ref SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10() function, to indicate that data is to be written to the storage medium. */ + #define DATA_WRITE false + + /** Value for the DeviceType entry in the SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t enum, indicating a Block Media device. */ + #define DEVICE_TYPE_BLOCK 0x00 + + /** Value for the DeviceType entry in the SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t enum, indicating a CD-ROM device. */ + #define DEVICE_TYPE_CDROM 0x05 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + bool SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_SCSI_C) + static bool SCSI_Command_Inquiry(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const bool IsDataRead); + static bool SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/MassStorage.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/MassStorage.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7cf8a3e5d2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/MassStorage.c @@ -0,0 +1,162 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the MassStorage demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "MassStorage.h" + +/** LUFA Mass Storage Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all Mass Storage Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t Disk_MS_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR, + .Size = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR, + .Size = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .TotalLUNs = TOTAL_LUNS, + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + MS_Device_USBTask(&Disk_MS_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + Dataflash_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Check if the Dataflash is working, abort if not */ + if (!(DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation())) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); + } + + /* Clear Dataflash sector protections, if enabled */ + DataflashManager_ResetDataflashProtections(); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= MS_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Disk_MS_Interface); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + MS_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Disk_MS_Interface); +} + +/** Mass Storage class driver callback function the reception of SCSI commands from the host, which must be processed. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface configuration structure being referenced + */ +bool CALLBACK_MS_Device_SCSICommandReceived(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + bool CommandSuccess; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + CommandSuccess = SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(MSInterfaceInfo); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + + return CommandSuccess; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/MassStorage.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/MassStorage.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2d07a21985 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/MassStorage.h @@ -0,0 +1,83 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for MassStorage.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MASS_STORAGE_H_ +#define _MASS_STORAGE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include "Lib/SCSI.h" + #include "Lib/DataflashManager.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + + bool CALLBACK_MS_Device_SCSICommandReceived(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/MassStorage.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/MassStorage.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5759efa6b4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/MassStorage.txt @@ -0,0 +1,100 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Mass Storage Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Mass Storage Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Bulk-Only Transport</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Mass Storage Standard \n + * USB Bulk-Only Transport Standard \n + * SCSI Primary Commands Specification \n + * SCSI Block Commands Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Mass Storage device demonstration application. This gives a simple + * reference application for implementing a USB Mass Storage device using + * the basic USB UFI drivers in all modern OSes (i.e. no special drivers + * required). + * + * On start-up the system will automatically enumerate and function as an + * external mass storage device which may be formatted and used in the same + * manner as commercial USB Mass Storage devices. + * + * You will need to format the mass storage drive upon first run of this + * demonstration - as the device acts only as a data block transport between + * the host and the storage media, it does not matter what file system is used, + * as the data interpretation is performed by the host and not the USB device. + * + * This demo is not restricted to only a single LUN (logical disk); by changing + * the TOTAL_LUNS value in DataflashManager.h, any number of LUNs can be used + * (from 1 to 255), with each LUN being allocated an equal portion of the available + * Dataflash memory. + * + * The USB control endpoint is managed entirely by the library using endpoint + * interrupts, as the INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT option is enabled. This allows for + * the host to reset the Mass Storage device state during long transfers without + * the need for complicated polling logic. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>TOTAL_LUNS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Total number of Logical Units (drives) in the device. The total device capacity is shared equally between each drive - + * this can be set to any positive non-zero amount.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>DISK_READ_ONLY</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Configuration define, indicating if the disk should be write protected or not.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6f5a8dc03e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,67 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Mass Storage Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.mass_storage.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.mass_storage"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Mass Storage Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.mass_storage.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.mass_storage"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.class.mass_storage" caption="Mass Storage Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Mass Storage device demo, implementing a basic USB storage disk using a Dataflash memory IC. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="Mass Storage Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="MassStorage.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="MassStorage.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/DataflashManager.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/SCSI.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="MassStorage.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/DataflashManager.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/SCSI.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.dataflash"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..84c2d3d0b6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Mass Storage Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3239b24db1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorage/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = MassStorage +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c Lib/DataflashManager.c Lib/SCSI.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b18b2c4149 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define TOTAL_LUNS 1 + + #define DISK_READ_ONLY false + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..62549878d6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 5 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..15cbc63b26 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,254 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2010 Matthias Hullin (lufa [at] matthias [dot] hullin [dot] net) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + + +/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the + * USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This + * descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding) + * the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for + * more details on HID report descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t PROGMEM KeyboardReport[] = +{ + /* Use the HID class driver's standard Keyboard report. + * Max simultaneous keys: 6 + */ + HID_DESCRIPTOR_KEYBOARD(6) +}; + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2061, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED, + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .MS_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = MS_CSCP_MassStorageClass, + .SubClass = MS_CSCP_SCSITransparentSubclass, + .Protocol = MS_CSCP_BulkOnlyTransportProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MS_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .MS_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .HID_KeyboardInterface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_BootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_KeyboardBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID_KeyboardHID = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(KeyboardReport) + }, + + .HID_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = KEYBOARD_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = KEYBOARD_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Mass Storage and Keyboard Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + case HID_DTYPE_HID: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID_KeyboardHID; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + break; + case HID_DTYPE_Report: + Address = &KeyboardReport; + Size = sizeof(KeyboardReport); + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b16e900e4e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,111 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2010 Matthias Hullin (lufa [at] matthias [dot] hullin [dot] net) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Keyboard HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define KEYBOARD_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Size in bytes of the Keyboard HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define KEYBOARD_EPSIZE 8 + + /** Endpoint address of the Mass Storage device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the Mass Storage host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) + + /** Size in bytes of the Mass Storage data endpoints. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE 64 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Mass Storage Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t MS_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t MS_DataInEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t MS_DataOutEndpoint; + + // Generic HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID_KeyboardInterface; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID_KeyboardHID; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID_ReportINEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage = 0, /**< Mass storage interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard = 1, /**< Keyboard interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Lib/DataflashManager.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Lib/DataflashManager.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c0fd16ccc4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Lib/DataflashManager.c @@ -0,0 +1,534 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Functions to manage the physical Dataflash media, including reading and writing of + * blocks of data. These functions are called by the SCSI layer when data must be stored + * or retrieved to/from the physical storage media. If a different media is used (such + * as a SD card or EEPROM), functions similar to these will need to be generated. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_DATAFLASHMANAGER_C +#include "DataflashManager.h" + +/** Writes blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) to the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), from + * the pre-selected data OUT endpoint. This routine reads in OS sized blocks from the endpoint and writes + * them to the Dataflash in Dataflash page sized blocks. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Mass Storage Class configuration and state + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the write sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to write + */ +void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + bool UsingSecondBuffer = false; + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, CurrDFPageByte); + + /* Wait until endpoint is ready before continuing */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Write an endpoint packet sized data block to the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if the endpoint is currently empty */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + /* Clear the current endpoint bank */ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + /* Wait until the host has sent another packet */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + } + + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Once all the Dataflash ICs have had their first buffers filled, switch buffers to maintain throughput */ + if (Dataflash_GetSelectedChip() == DATAFLASH_CHIP_MASK(DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS)) + UsingSecondBuffer = !(UsingSecondBuffer); + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* If less than one Dataflash page remaining, copy over the existing page to preserve trailing data */ + if ((TotalBlocks * (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) < (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF2 : DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + } +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2WRITE : DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, 0); + } + + /* Write one 16-byte chunk of data to the Dataflash */ + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + + /* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ + if (MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset) + return; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0x00); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + + /* If the endpoint is empty, clear it ready for the next packet from the host */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Reads blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) from the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), into + * the pre-selected data IN endpoint. This routine reads in Dataflash page sized blocks from the Dataflash + * and writes them in OS sized blocks to the endpoint. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Mass Storage Class configuration and state + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the read sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to read + */ +void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, CurrDFPageByte); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + + /* Wait until endpoint is ready before continuing */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Read an endpoint packet sized data block from the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if the endpoint is currently full */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + /* Clear the endpoint bank to send its contents to the host */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Wait until the endpoint is ready for more data */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + } + + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + } + + /* Read one 16-byte chunk of data from the Dataflash */ + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + + /* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ + if (MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset) + return; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* If the endpoint is full, send its contents to the host */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Writes blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) to the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), from + * the given RAM buffer. This routine reads in OS sized blocks from the buffer and writes them to the + * Dataflash in Dataflash page sized blocks. This can be linked to FAT libraries to write files to the + * Dataflash. + * + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the write sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to write + * \param[in] BufferPtr Pointer to the data source RAM buffer + */ +void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + bool UsingSecondBuffer = false; + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, CurrDFPageByte); + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Write an endpoint packet sized data block to the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Once all the Dataflash ICs have had their first buffers filled, switch buffers to maintain throughput */ + if (Dataflash_GetSelectedChip() == DATAFLASH_CHIP_MASK(DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS)) + UsingSecondBuffer = !(UsingSecondBuffer); + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* If less than one Dataflash page remaining, copy over the existing page to preserve trailing data */ + if ((TotalBlocks * (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) < (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF2 : DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + } +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2WRITE : DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, 0); + } + + /* Write one 16-byte chunk of data to the Dataflash */ + for (uint8_t ByteNum = 0; ByteNum < 16; ByteNum++) + Dataflash_SendByte(*(BufferPtr++)); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0x00); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Reads blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) from the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), into + * the preallocated RAM buffer. This routine reads in Dataflash page sized blocks from the Dataflash + * and writes them in OS sized blocks to the given buffer. This can be linked to FAT libraries to read + * the files stored on the Dataflash. + * + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the read sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to read + * \param[out] BufferPtr Pointer to the data destination RAM buffer + */ +void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, CurrDFPageByte); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Read an endpoint packet sized data block from the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + } + + /* Read one 16-byte chunk of data from the Dataflash */ + for (uint8_t ByteNum = 0; ByteNum < 16; ByteNum++) + *(BufferPtr++) = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Disables the Dataflash memory write protection bits on the board Dataflash ICs, if enabled. */ +void DataflashManager_ResetDataflashProtections(void) +{ + /* Select first Dataflash chip, send the read status register command */ + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + + /* Check if sector protection is enabled */ + if (Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_SECTORPROTECTION_ON) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + + /* Send the commands to disable sector protection */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[0]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[1]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[2]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[3]); + } + + /* Select second Dataflash chip (if present on selected board), send read status register command */ + #if (DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS == 2) + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP2); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + + /* Check if sector protection is enabled */ + if (Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_SECTORPROTECTION_ON) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + + /* Send the commands to disable sector protection */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[0]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[1]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[2]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[3]); + } + #endif + + /* Deselect current Dataflash chip */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Performs a simple test on the attached Dataflash IC(s) to ensure that they are working. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if all media chips are working, \c false otherwise + */ +bool DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation(void) +{ + uint8_t ReturnByte; + + /* Test first Dataflash IC is present and responding to commands */ + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_READMANUFACTURERDEVICEINFO); + ReturnByte = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + /* If returned data is invalid, fail the command */ + if (ReturnByte != DF_MANUFACTURER_ATMEL) + return false; + + #if (DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS == 2) + /* Test second Dataflash IC is present and responding to commands */ + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP2); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_READMANUFACTURERDEVICEINFO); + ReturnByte = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + /* If returned data is invalid, fail the command */ + if (ReturnByte != DF_MANUFACTURER_ATMEL) + return false; + #endif + + return true; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Lib/DataflashManager.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Lib/DataflashManager.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..076847a7d6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Lib/DataflashManager.h @@ -0,0 +1,87 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for DataflashManager.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DATAFLASH_MANAGER_H_ +#define _DATAFLASH_MANAGER_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + + #include "../MassStorageKeyboard.h" + #include "../Descriptors.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h> + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE % 16) + #error Dataflash page size must be a multiple of 16 bytes. + #endif + + /* Defines: */ + /** Total number of bytes of the storage medium, comprised of one or more Dataflash ICs. */ + #define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES ((uint32_t)DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) + + /** Block size of the device. This is kept at 512 to remain compatible with the OS despite the underlying + * storage media (Dataflash) using a different native block size. + */ + #define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE 512 + + /** Total number of blocks of the virtual memory for reporting to the host as the device's total capacity. */ + #define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCKS (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES / VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + + /** Blocks in each LUN, calculated from the total capacity divided by the total number of Logical Units in the device. */ + #define LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCKS / TOTAL_LUNS) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks); + void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks); + void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + void DataflashManager_ResetDataflashProtections(void); + bool DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Lib/SCSI.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Lib/SCSI.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8780d1603d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Lib/SCSI.c @@ -0,0 +1,349 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * SCSI command processing routines, for SCSI commands issued by the host. Mass Storage + * devices use a thin "Bulk-Only Transport" protocol for issuing commands and status information, + * which wrap around standard SCSI device commands for controlling the actual storage medium. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_SCSI_C +#include "SCSI.h" + +/** Structure to hold the SCSI response data to a SCSI INQUIRY command. This gives information about the device's + * features and capabilities. + */ +static const SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t InquiryData = + { + .DeviceType = DEVICE_TYPE_BLOCK, + .PeripheralQualifier = 0, + + .Removable = true, + + .Version = 0, + + .ResponseDataFormat = 2, + .NormACA = false, + .TrmTsk = false, + .AERC = false, + + .AdditionalLength = 0x1F, + + .SoftReset = false, + .CmdQue = false, + .Linked = false, + .Sync = false, + .WideBus16Bit = false, + .WideBus32Bit = false, + .RelAddr = false, + + .VendorID = "LUFA", + .ProductID = "Dataflash Disk", + .RevisionID = {'0','.','0','0'}, + }; + +/** Structure to hold the sense data for the last issued SCSI command, which is returned to the host after a SCSI REQUEST SENSE + * command is issued. This gives information on exactly why the last command failed to complete. + */ +static SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t SenseData = + { + .ResponseCode = 0x70, + .AdditionalLength = 0x0A, + }; + + +/** Main routine to process the SCSI command located in the Command Block Wrapper read from the host. This dispatches + * to the appropriate SCSI command handling routine if the issued command is supported by the device, else it returns + * a command failure due to a ILLEGAL REQUEST. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise + */ +bool SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + bool CommandSuccess = false; + + /* Run the appropriate SCSI command hander function based on the passed command */ + switch (MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[0]) + { + case SCSI_CMD_INQUIRY: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Inquiry(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_REQUEST_SENSE: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_READ_CAPACITY_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_SEND_DIAGNOSTIC: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_WRITE_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(MSInterfaceInfo, DATA_WRITE); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_READ_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(MSInterfaceInfo, DATA_READ); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_MODE_SENSE_6: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_START_STOP_UNIT: + case SCSI_CMD_TEST_UNIT_READY: + case SCSI_CMD_PREVENT_ALLOW_MEDIUM_REMOVAL: + case SCSI_CMD_VERIFY_10: + /* These commands should just succeed, no handling required */ + CommandSuccess = true; + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength = 0; + break; + default: + /* Update the SENSE key to reflect the invalid command */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_COMMAND, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + break; + } + + /* Check if command was successfully processed */ + if (CommandSuccess) + { + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_GOOD, + SCSI_ASENSE_NO_ADDITIONAL_INFORMATION, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return true; + } + + return false; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI INQUIRY command. This command returns information about the device's features + * and capabilities to the host. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Inquiry(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint16_t AllocationLength = SwapEndian_16(*(uint16_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[3]); + uint16_t BytesTransferred = MIN(AllocationLength, sizeof(InquiryData)); + + /* Only the standard INQUIRY data is supported, check if any optional INQUIRY bits set */ + if ((MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[1] & ((1 << 0) | (1 << 1))) || + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[2]) + { + /* Optional but unsupported bits set - update the SENSE key and fail the request */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_FIELD_IN_CDB, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&InquiryData, BytesTransferred, NULL); + + /* Pad out remaining bytes with 0x00 */ + Endpoint_Null_Stream((AllocationLength - BytesTransferred), NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= BytesTransferred; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI REQUEST SENSE command. This command returns information about the last issued command, + * including the error code and additional error information so that the host can determine why a command failed to complete. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint8_t AllocationLength = MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[4]; + uint8_t BytesTransferred = MIN(AllocationLength, sizeof(SenseData)); + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&SenseData, BytesTransferred, NULL); + Endpoint_Null_Stream((AllocationLength - BytesTransferred), NULL); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= BytesTransferred; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI READ CAPACITY (10) command. This command returns information about the device's capacity + * on the selected Logical Unit (drive), as a number of OS-sized blocks. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint32_t LastBlockAddressInLUN = (LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS - 1); + uint32_t MediaBlockSize = VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE; + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE(&LastBlockAddressInLUN, sizeof(LastBlockAddressInLUN), NULL); + Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE(&MediaBlockSize, sizeof(MediaBlockSize), NULL); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= 8; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI SEND DIAGNOSTIC command. This command performs a quick check of the Dataflash ICs on the + * board, and indicates if they are present and functioning correctly. Only the Self-Test portion of the diagnostic command is + * supported. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + /* Check to see if the SELF TEST bit is not set */ + if (!(MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[1] & (1 << 2))) + { + /* Only self-test supported - update SENSE key and fail the command */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_FIELD_IN_CDB, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Check to see if all attached Dataflash ICs are functional */ + if (!(DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation())) + { + /* Update SENSE key with a hardware error condition and return command fail */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_HARDWARE_ERROR, + SCSI_ASENSE_NO_ADDITIONAL_INFORMATION, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength = 0; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI READ (10) or WRITE (10) command. This command reads in the block start address + * and total number of blocks to process, then calls the appropriate low-level Dataflash routine to handle the actual + * reading and writing of the data. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * \param[in] IsDataRead Indicates if the command is a READ (10) command or WRITE (10) command (DATA_READ or DATA_WRITE) + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const bool IsDataRead) +{ + uint32_t BlockAddress; + uint16_t TotalBlocks; + + /* Check if the disk is write protected or not */ + if ((IsDataRead == DATA_WRITE) && DISK_READ_ONLY) + { + /* Block address is invalid, update SENSE key and return command fail */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_DATA_PROTECT, + SCSI_ASENSE_WRITE_PROTECTED, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Load in the 32-bit block address (SCSI uses big-endian, so have to reverse the byte order) */ + BlockAddress = SwapEndian_32(*(uint32_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[2]); + + /* Load in the 16-bit total blocks (SCSI uses big-endian, so have to reverse the byte order) */ + TotalBlocks = SwapEndian_16(*(uint16_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[7]); + + /* Check if the block address is outside the maximum allowable value for the LUN */ + if (BlockAddress >= LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS) + { + /* Block address is invalid, update SENSE key and return command fail */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_LOGICAL_BLOCK_ADDRESS_OUT_OF_RANGE, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + #if (TOTAL_LUNS > 1) + /* Adjust the given block address to the real media address based on the selected LUN */ + BlockAddress += ((uint32_t)MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.LUN * LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS); + #endif + + /* Determine if the packet is a READ (10) or WRITE (10) command, call appropriate function */ + if (IsDataRead == DATA_READ) + DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(MSInterfaceInfo, BlockAddress, TotalBlocks); + else + DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(MSInterfaceInfo, BlockAddress, TotalBlocks); + + /* Update the bytes transferred counter and succeed the command */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= ((uint32_t)TotalBlocks * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE); + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI MODE SENSE (6) command. This command returns various informational pages about + * the SCSI device, as well as the device's Write Protect status. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + /* Send an empty header response with the Write Protect flag status */ + Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); + Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); + Endpoint_Write_8(DISK_READ_ONLY ? 0x80 : 0x00); + Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Update the bytes transferred counter and succeed the command */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= 4; + + return true; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Lib/SCSI.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Lib/SCSI.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c442e45386 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/Lib/SCSI.h @@ -0,0 +1,89 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for SCSI.c. + */ + +#ifndef _SCSI_H_ +#define _SCSI_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "../MassStorageKeyboard.h" + #include "../Descriptors.h" + #include "DataflashManager.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Macro to set the current SCSI sense data to the given key, additional sense code and additional sense qualifier. This + * is for convenience, as it allows for all three sense values (returned upon request to the host to give information about + * the last command failure) in a quick and easy manner. + * + * \param[in] Key New SCSI sense key to set the sense code to + * \param[in] Acode New SCSI additional sense key to set the additional sense code to + * \param[in] Aqual New SCSI additional sense key qualifier to set the additional sense qualifier code to + */ + #define SCSI_SET_SENSE(Key, Acode, Aqual) do { SenseData.SenseKey = (Key); \ + SenseData.AdditionalSenseCode = (Acode); \ + SenseData.AdditionalSenseQualifier = (Aqual); } while (0) + + /** Macro for the \ref SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10() function, to indicate that data is to be read from the storage medium. */ + #define DATA_READ true + + /** Macro for the \ref SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10() function, to indicate that data is to be written to the storage medium. */ + #define DATA_WRITE false + + /** Value for the DeviceType entry in the SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t enum, indicating a Block Media device. */ + #define DEVICE_TYPE_BLOCK 0x00 + + /** Value for the DeviceType entry in the SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t enum, indicating a CD-ROM device. */ + #define DEVICE_TYPE_CDROM 0x05 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + bool SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_SCSI_C) + static bool SCSI_Command_Inquiry(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const bool IsDataRead); + static bool SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/MassStorageKeyboard.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/MassStorageKeyboard.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3a1b7805e9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/MassStorageKeyboard.c @@ -0,0 +1,270 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2010 Matthias Hullin (lufa [at] matthias [dot] hullin [dot] net) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the MassStorageKeyboard demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "MassStorageKeyboard.h" + +/** LUFA Mass Storage Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all Mass Storage Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t Disk_MS_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR, + .Size = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR, + .Size = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .TotalLUNs = TOTAL_LUNS, + }, + }; + +/** Buffer to hold the previously generated Keyboard HID report, for comparison purposes inside the HID class driver. */ +static uint8_t PrevKeyboardHIDReportBuffer[sizeof(USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t)]; + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t Keyboard_HID_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard, + .ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Address = KEYBOARD_EPADDR, + .Size = KEYBOARD_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .PrevReportINBuffer = PrevKeyboardHIDReportBuffer, + .PrevReportINBufferSize = sizeof(PrevKeyboardHIDReportBuffer), + }, + }; + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + MS_Device_USBTask(&Disk_MS_Interface); + HID_Device_USBTask(&Keyboard_HID_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + Joystick_Init(); + Buttons_Init(); + Dataflash_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Check if the Dataflash is working, abort if not */ + if (!(DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation())) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); + } + + /* Clear Dataflash sector protections, if enabled */ + DataflashManager_ResetDataflashProtections(); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= HID_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Keyboard_HID_Interface); + ConfigSuccess &= MS_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Disk_MS_Interface); + + USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + MS_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Disk_MS_Interface); + HID_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Keyboard_HID_Interface); +} + +/** Mass Storage class driver callback function the reception of SCSI commands from the host, which must be processed. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface configuration structure being referenced + */ +bool CALLBACK_MS_Device_SCSICommandReceived(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + bool CommandSuccess; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + CommandSuccess = SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(MSInterfaceInfo); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + + return CommandSuccess; +} + +/** Event handler for the USB device Start Of Frame event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void) +{ + HID_Device_MillisecondElapsed(&Keyboard_HID_Interface); +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the creation of HID reports to the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in,out] ReportID Report ID requested by the host if non-zero, otherwise callback should set to the generated report ID + * \param[in] ReportType Type of the report to create, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_In or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[out] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the created report should be stored + * \param[out] ReportSize Number of bytes written in the report (or zero if no report is to be sent) + * + * \return Boolean \c true to force the sending of the report, \c false to let the library determine if it needs to be sent + */ +bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize) +{ + USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t* KeyboardReport = (USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t*)ReportData; + + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + uint8_t ButtonStatus_LCL = Buttons_GetStatus(); + + KeyboardReport->Modifier = HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFIER_LEFTSHIFT; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_A; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_B; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_C; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_D; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_E; + + if (ButtonStatus_LCL & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F; + + *ReportSize = sizeof(USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t); + return false; +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the processing of HID reports from the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in] ReportID Report ID of the received report from the host + * \param[in] ReportType The type of report that the host has sent, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_Out or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[in] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the received report has been stored + * \param[in] ReportSize Size in bytes of the received HID report + */ +void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize) +{ + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS; + uint8_t* LEDReport = (uint8_t*)ReportData; + + if (*LEDReport & HID_KEYBOARD_LED_NUMLOCK) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED1; + + if (*LEDReport & HID_KEYBOARD_LED_CAPSLOCK) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED3; + + if (*LEDReport & HID_KEYBOARD_LED_SCROLLLOCK) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED4; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/MassStorageKeyboard.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/MassStorageKeyboard.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e122a4913a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/MassStorageKeyboard.h @@ -0,0 +1,100 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2010 Matthias Hullin (lufa [at] matthias [dot] hullin [dot] net) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for MassStorageKeyboard.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MASS_STORAGE_KEYBOARD_H_ +#define _MASS_STORAGE_KEYBOARD_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include "Lib/SCSI.h" + #include "Lib/DataflashManager.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void); + + bool CALLBACK_MS_Device_SCSICommandReceived(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + + bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize); + void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/MassStorageKeyboard.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/MassStorageKeyboard.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d8b3b31db1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/MassStorageKeyboard.txt @@ -0,0 +1,100 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Combined Mass Storage and Keyboard Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Classes:</b></td> + * <td>Mass Storage Device \n + * Human Interface Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclasses:</b></td> + * <td>Bulk-Only Transport \n + * Keyboard Subclass</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Mass Storage Standard \n + * USB Bulk-Only Transport Standard \n + * SCSI Primary Commands Specification \n + * SCSI Block Commands Specification \n + * USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Combined Mass Storage and Keyboard demonstration application. This gives a + * simple reference application for implementing a dual class USB Mass Storage + * and USB HID Keyboard device using the basic USB UFI and HID drivers in all + * modern OSes (i.e. no special drivers required). + * + * On start-up the system will automatically enumerate and function as an + * external mass storage device (which may be formatted and used in the same + * manner as commercial USB Mass Storage devices) and a USB keyboard. + * + * You will need to format the mass storage drive upon first run of this + * demonstration - as the device acts only as a data block transport between + * the host and the storage media, it does not matter what file system is used, + * as the data interpretation is performed by the host and not the USB device. + * + * Keys on the USB keyboard can be pressed by moving the board's Joystick. + * + * The USB control endpoint is managed entirely by the library using endpoint + * interrupts, as the INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT option is enabled. This allows for + * the host to reset the Mass Storage device state during long transfers without + * the need for complicated polling logic. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>TOTAL_LUNS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Total number of Logical Units (drives) in the device. The total device capacity is shared equally between each drive - + * this can be set to any positive non-zero amount.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>DISK_READ_ONLY</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Configuration define, indicating if the disk should be write protected or not.</td> + * </tr> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3cdb476b28 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,70 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Mass Storage and HID Keyboard Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.mass_storage_keyboard.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.mass_storage_keyboard"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Mass Storage and HID Keyboard Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.mass_storage_keyboard.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.mass_storage_keyboard"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.class.mass_storage_keyboard" caption="Mass Storage and HID Keyboard Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Mass Storage and Keyboard device demo, implementing a basic USB storage disk using a Dataflash memory IC, and a basic HID keyboard. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ <keyword value="Mass Storage Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="MassStorageKeyboard.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="MassStorageKeyboard.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/DataflashManager.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/SCSI.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="MassStorageKeyboard.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/DataflashManager.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/SCSI.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.dataflash"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7f0c541ba1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Combined Mass Storage and Keyboard Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4768cfc9b7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/MassStorageKeyboard/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = MassStorageKeyboard +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c Lib/DataflashManager.c Lib/SCSI.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..299d2ec852 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 1 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..af08f81cfa --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,221 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the + * USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This + * descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding) + * the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for + * more details on HID report descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t PROGMEM MouseReport[] = +{ + /* Use the HID class driver's standard Mouse report. + * Min X/Y Axis values: -1 + * Max X/Y Axis values: 1 + * Min physical X/Y Axis values (used to determine resolution): -1 + * Max physical X/Y Axis values (used to determine resolution): 1 + * Buttons: 3 + * Absolute screen coordinates: false + */ + HID_DESCRIPTOR_MOUSE(-1, 1, -1, 1, 3, false) +}; + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2041, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .HID_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Mouse, + .AlternateSetting = 0x00, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_BootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_MouseBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID_MouseHID = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(MouseReport) + }, + + .HID_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MOUSE_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MOUSE_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Mouse Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + case HID_DTYPE_HID: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID_MouseHID; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + break; + case HID_DTYPE_Report: + Address = &MouseReport; + Size = sizeof(MouseReport); + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b3fc968908 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Mouse HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define MOUSE_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Size in bytes of the Mouse HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define MOUSE_EPSIZE 8 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Mouse HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID_Interface; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID_MouseHID; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID_ReportINEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_Mouse = 0, /**< Mouse interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/Mouse.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/Mouse.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..475fb62ad1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/Mouse.c @@ -0,0 +1,202 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the Mouse demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "Mouse.h" + +/** Buffer to hold the previously generated Mouse HID report, for comparison purposes inside the HID class driver. */ +static uint8_t PrevMouseHIDReportBuffer[sizeof(USB_MouseReport_Data_t)]; + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t Mouse_HID_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Mouse, + .ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Address = MOUSE_EPADDR, + .Size = MOUSE_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .PrevReportINBuffer = PrevMouseHIDReportBuffer, + .PrevReportINBufferSize = sizeof(PrevMouseHIDReportBuffer), + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + HID_Device_USBTask(&Mouse_HID_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Joystick_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + Buttons_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= HID_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Mouse_HID_Interface); + + USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + HID_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Mouse_HID_Interface); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB device Start Of Frame event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void) +{ + HID_Device_MillisecondElapsed(&Mouse_HID_Interface); +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the creation of HID reports to the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in,out] ReportID Report ID requested by the host if non-zero, otherwise callback should set to the generated report ID + * \param[in] ReportType Type of the report to create, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_In or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[out] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the created report should be stored + * \param[out] ReportSize Number of bytes written in the report (or zero if no report is to be sent) + * + * \return Boolean \c true to force the sending of the report, \c false to let the library determine if it needs to be sent + */ +bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize) +{ + USB_MouseReport_Data_t* MouseReport = (USB_MouseReport_Data_t*)ReportData; + + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + uint8_t ButtonStatus_LCL = Buttons_GetStatus(); + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + MouseReport->Y = -1; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + MouseReport->Y = 1; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + MouseReport->X = -1; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + MouseReport->X = 1; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + MouseReport->Button |= (1 << 0); + + if (ButtonStatus_LCL & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) + MouseReport->Button |= (1 << 1); + + *ReportSize = sizeof(USB_MouseReport_Data_t); + return true; +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the processing of HID reports from the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in] ReportID Report ID of the received report from the host + * \param[in] ReportType The type of report that the host has sent, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_Out or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[in] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the received report has been stored + * \param[in] ReportSize Size in bytes of the received HID report + */ +void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize) +{ + // Unused (but mandatory for the HID class driver) in this demo, since there are no Host->Device reports +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/Mouse.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/Mouse.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..62bf47d7b3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/Mouse.h @@ -0,0 +1,90 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Mouse.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MOUSE_H_ +#define _MOUSE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void); + + bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize); + void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/Mouse.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/Mouse.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dc65b88793 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/Mouse.txt @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Mouse Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Mouse Subclass</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Mouse demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Mouse using the basic USB HID + * drivers in all modern OSes (i.e. no special drivers required). It is + * boot protocol compatible, and thus works under compatible BIOS as if + * it was a native mouse (e.g. PS/2). + * + * On start-up the system will automatically enumerate and function + * as a mouse when the USB connection to a host is present. To use + * the mouse, move the joystick to move the pointer, and push the + * joystick inwards to simulate a left-button click. The HWB serves as + * the right mouse button. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1af0d76671 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Mouse HID Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.mouse.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.mouse"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Mouse HID Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.mouse.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.mouse"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.class.mouse" caption="Mouse HID Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Mouse device demo, implementing a basic USB mouse device that can send movement information to the host. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="Mouse.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Mouse.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Mouse.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..37bc830184 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Mouse Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0ca85b318b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/Mouse/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = Mouse +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0e4d1780a9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,60 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define CLIENT_IP_ADDRESS { 10, 0, 0, 1} + #define SERVER_IP_ADDRESS { 10, 0, 0, 2} + + #define ADAPTER_MAC_ADDRESS {0x02, 0x00, 0x02, 0x00, 0x02, 0x00} + #define SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS {0x00, 0x01, 0x00, 0x01, 0x00, 0x01} + + #define NO_DECODE_ETHERNET + #define NO_DECODE_ARP + #define NO_DECODE_IP + #define NO_DECODE_ICMP + #define NO_DECODE_TCP + #define NO_DECODE_UDP + #define NO_DECODE_DHCP + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cc828a108d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 3 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e42b318602 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,244 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x204C, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .CDC_CCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_VendorSpecificProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Header = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .CDCSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + }, + + .CDC_Functional_ACM = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ACM, + + .Capabilities = 0x00, + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Union = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Union, + + .MasterInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .SlaveInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + }, + + .CDC_NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0xFF + }, + + .CDC_DCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .RNDIS_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .RNDIS_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA RNDIS CDC Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..866ccd61ab --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,112 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_TX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define CDC_RX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE 8 + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC data IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE 64 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // RNDIS CDC Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_CCI_Interface; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t CDC_Functional_Header; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t CDC_Functional_ACM; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t CDC_Functional_Union; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_NotificationEndpoint; + + // RNDIS CDC Data Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_DCI_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t RNDIS_DataOutEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t RNDIS_DataInEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI = 0, /**< CDC CCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI = 1, /**< CDC DCI interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/LUFA RNDIS.inf b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/LUFA RNDIS.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f34e55f995 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/LUFA RNDIS.inf @@ -0,0 +1,59 @@ +; Windows LUFA RNDIS Setup File +; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation + +[DefaultInstall] +CopyINF="LUFA RNDIS.inf" + +[Version] +Signature="$Windows NT$" +Class=Net +ClassGuid={4d36e972-e325-11ce-bfc1-08002be10318} +Provider=%MFGNAME% +DriverVer=7/1/2012,10.0.0.0 + +[Manufacturer] +%MFGNAME%=DeviceList, NTx86, NTamd64, NTia64 + +[ControlFlags] +ExcludeFromSelect=* + +[DriverInstall] +Characteristics=0x84 ; NCF_PHYSICAL + NCF_HAS_UI +BusType=15 +include=netrndis.inf +needs=Usb_Rndis.ndi +AddReg=Rndis_AddReg_Vista + +[DriverInstall.Services] +include=netrndis.inf +needs=Usb_Rndis.ndi.Services + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; Vendor and Product ID Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; When developing your USB device, the VID and PID used in the PC side +; application program and the firmware on the microcontroller must match. +; Modify the below line to use your VID and PID. Use the format as shown below. +; Note: One INF file can be used for multiple devices with different VID and PIDs. +; For each supported device, append ",USB\VID_xxxx&PID_yyyy" to the end of the line. +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[DeviceList] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204C + +[DeviceList.NTx86] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204C + +[DeviceList.NTamd64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204C + +[DeviceList.NTia64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204C + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; String Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +;Modify these strings to customize your device +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[Strings] +MFGNAME="http://www.lufa-lib.org" +DESCRIPTION="LUFA USB RNDIS Demo" diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ARP.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ARP.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..518ba8c6a1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ARP.c @@ -0,0 +1,87 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) packet handling routines. This protocol handles the + * conversion of physical MAC addresses to protocol IP addresses between the host and the + * device. + */ + +#include "ARP.h" + +/** Processes an ARP packet inside an Ethernet frame, and writes the appropriate response + * to the output Ethernet frame if the host is requesting the IP or MAC address of the + * virtual server device on the network. + * + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of the incoming packet's ARP header + * \param[out] OutDataStart Pointer to the start of the outgoing packet's ARP header + * + * \return The number of bytes written to the out Ethernet frame if any, NO_RESPONSE otherwise + */ +int16_t ARP_ProcessARPPacket(void* InDataStart, + void* OutDataStart) +{ + DecodeARPHeader(InDataStart); + + ARP_Header_t* ARPHeaderIN = (ARP_Header_t*)InDataStart; + ARP_Header_t* ARPHeaderOUT = (ARP_Header_t*)OutDataStart; + + /* Ensure that the ARP request is a IPv4 request packet */ + if ((SwapEndian_16(ARPHeaderIN->ProtocolType) == ETHERTYPE_IPV4) && + (SwapEndian_16(ARPHeaderIN->Operation) == ARP_OPERATION_REQUEST)) + { + /* If the ARP packet is requesting the MAC or IP of the virtual webserver, return the response */ + if (IP_COMPARE(&ARPHeaderIN->TPA, &ServerIPAddress) || + MAC_COMPARE(&ARPHeaderIN->THA, &ServerMACAddress)) + { + /* Fill out the ARP response header */ + ARPHeaderOUT->HardwareType = ARPHeaderIN->HardwareType; + ARPHeaderOUT->ProtocolType = ARPHeaderIN->ProtocolType; + ARPHeaderOUT->HLEN = ARPHeaderIN->HLEN; + ARPHeaderOUT->PLEN = ARPHeaderIN->PLEN; + ARPHeaderOUT->Operation = SwapEndian_16(ARP_OPERATION_REPLY); + + /* Copy over the sender MAC/IP to the target fields for the response */ + ARPHeaderOUT->THA = ARPHeaderIN->SHA; + ARPHeaderOUT->TPA = ARPHeaderIN->SPA; + + /* Copy over the new sender MAC/IP - MAC and IP addresses of the virtual webserver */ + ARPHeaderOUT->SHA = ServerMACAddress; + ARPHeaderOUT->SPA = ServerIPAddress; + + /* Return the size of the response so far */ + return sizeof(ARP_Header_t); + } + } + + return NO_RESPONSE; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ARP.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ARP.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e64c38ec5f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ARP.h @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ARP.c. + */ + +#ifndef _ARP_H_ +#define _ARP_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "EthernetProtocols.h" + #include "Ethernet.h" + #include "ProtocolDecoders.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** ARP header operation constant, indicating a request from a host for an address translation. */ + #define ARP_OPERATION_REQUEST 1 + + /** ARP header operation constant, indicating a reply from a host giving an address translation. */ + #define ARP_OPERATION_REPLY 2 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for an ARP packet inside an Ethernet frame. */ + typedef struct + { + uint16_t HardwareType; /**< Hardware type constant, indicating the hardware used */ + uint16_t ProtocolType; /**< Protocol being resolved, usually ETHERTYPE_IPV4 */ + + uint8_t HLEN; /**< Length in bytes of the source/destination hardware addresses */ + uint8_t PLEN; /**< Length in bytes of the source/destination protocol addresses */ + uint16_t Operation; /**< Type of operation, either ARP_OPERATION_REQUEST or ARP_OPERATION_REPLY */ + + MAC_Address_t SHA; /**< Sender's hardware address */ + IP_Address_t SPA; /**< Sender's protocol address */ + MAC_Address_t THA; /**< Target's hardware address */ + IP_Address_t TPA; /**< Target's protocol address */ + } ARP_Header_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + int16_t ARP_ProcessARPPacket(void* InDataStart, + void* OutDataStart); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/DHCP.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/DHCP.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7adc648360 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/DHCP.c @@ -0,0 +1,129 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) packet handling routines. This protocol + * handles the automatic IP negotiation to the host, so that the host will use the provided + * IP address given to it by the device. + */ + +#include "DHCP.h" + +/** Processes a DHCP packet inside an Ethernet frame, and writes the appropriate response + * to the output Ethernet frame if the host is requesting or accepting an IP address. + * + * \param[in] IPHeaderInStart Pointer to the start of the incoming packet's IP header + * \param[in] DHCPHeaderInStart Pointer to the start of the incoming packet's DHCP header + * \param[out] DHCPHeaderOutStart Pointer to the start of the outgoing packet's DHCP header + * + * \return The number of bytes written to the out Ethernet frame if any, NO_RESPONSE otherwise + */ +int16_t DHCP_ProcessDHCPPacket(void* IPHeaderInStart, + void* DHCPHeaderInStart, + void* DHCPHeaderOutStart) +{ + IP_Header_t* IPHeaderIN = (IP_Header_t*)IPHeaderInStart; + DHCP_Header_t* DHCPHeaderIN = (DHCP_Header_t*)DHCPHeaderInStart; + DHCP_Header_t* DHCPHeaderOUT = (DHCP_Header_t*)DHCPHeaderOutStart; + + uint8_t* DHCPOptionsINStart = ((uint8_t*)DHCPHeaderInStart + sizeof(DHCP_Header_t)); + uint8_t* DHCPOptionsOUTStart = ((uint8_t*)DHCPHeaderOutStart + sizeof(DHCP_Header_t)); + + DecodeDHCPHeader(DHCPHeaderInStart); + + /* Zero out the response DHCP packet, as much of it is legacy and left at 0 */ + memset(DHCPHeaderOUT, 0, sizeof(DHCP_Header_t)); + + /* Fill out the response DHCP packet */ + DHCPHeaderOUT->HardwareType = DHCPHeaderIN->HardwareType; + DHCPHeaderOUT->Operation = DHCP_OP_BOOTREPLY; + DHCPHeaderOUT->HardwareAddressLength = DHCPHeaderIN->HardwareAddressLength; + DHCPHeaderOUT->Hops = 0; + DHCPHeaderOUT->TransactionID = DHCPHeaderIN->TransactionID; + DHCPHeaderOUT->ElapsedSeconds = 0; + DHCPHeaderOUT->Flags = DHCPHeaderIN->Flags; + DHCPHeaderOUT->YourIP = ClientIPAddress; + memmove(&DHCPHeaderOUT->ClientHardwareAddress, &DHCPHeaderIN->ClientHardwareAddress, sizeof(MAC_Address_t)); + DHCPHeaderOUT->Cookie = SwapEndian_32(DHCP_MAGIC_COOKIE); + + /* Alter the incoming IP packet header so that the corrected IP source and destinations are used - this means that + when the response IP header is generated, it will use the corrected addresses and not the null/broatcast addresses */ + IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress = ClientIPAddress; + IPHeaderIN->DestinationAddress = ServerIPAddress; + + /* Process the incoming DHCP packet options */ + while (DHCPOptionsINStart[0] != DHCP_OPTION_END) + { + /* Find the Message Type DHCP option, to determine the type of DHCP packet */ + if (DHCPOptionsINStart[0] == DHCP_OPTION_MESSAGETYPE) + { + if ((DHCPOptionsINStart[2] == DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_DISCOVER) || (DHCPOptionsINStart[2] == DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_REQUEST)) + { + /* Fill out the response DHCP packet options for a DHCP OFFER or ACK response */ + + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = DHCP_OPTION_MESSAGETYPE; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = 1; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = (DHCPOptionsINStart[2] == DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_DISCOVER) ? DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_OFFER + : DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_ACK; + + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = DHCP_OPTION_SUBNETMASK; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = sizeof(IP_Address_t); + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = 0xFF; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = 0xFF; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = 0xFF; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = 0x00; + + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = DHCP_OPTION_LEASETIME; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = sizeof(uint32_t); + /* Lease Time 86400s (ONE_DAY) */ + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = 0x00; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = 0x01; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = 0x51; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = 0x80; + + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = DHCP_OPTION_DHCPSERVER; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = sizeof(IP_Address_t); + memcpy(DHCPOptionsOUTStart, &ServerIPAddress, sizeof(IP_Address_t)); + DHCPOptionsOUTStart += sizeof(IP_Address_t); + + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = DHCP_OPTION_END; + + return (sizeof(DHCP_Header_t) + 18 + sizeof(IP_Address_t)); + } + } + + /* Go to the next DHCP option - skip one byte if option is a padding byte, else skip the complete option's size */ + DHCPOptionsINStart += ((DHCPOptionsINStart[0] == DHCP_OPTION_PAD) ? 1 : (DHCPOptionsINStart[1] + 2)); + } + + return NO_RESPONSE; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/DHCP.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/DHCP.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5ef78469ec --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/DHCP.h @@ -0,0 +1,131 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for DHCP.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DHCP_H_ +#define _DHCP_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "EthernetProtocols.h" + #include "Ethernet.h" + #include "ProtocolDecoders.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** DHCP operation constant, indicating a request from a host to a DHCP server. */ + #define DHCP_OP_BOOTREQUEST 0x01 + + /** DHCP operation constant, indicating a reply from a DHCP server to a host. */ + #define DHCP_OP_BOOTREPLY 0x02 + + /** Hardware type constant, indicating Ethernet as a carrier. */ + #define DHCP_HTYPE_ETHERNET 0x01 + + /** Magic boot protocol "cookie", inserted into all BOOTP packets (BOOTP is the carrier of DHCP). */ + #define DHCP_MAGIC_COOKIE 0x63825363 + + /** DHCP option list entry header, indicating that a subnet mask will follow. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_SUBNETMASK 1 + + /** DHCP option list entry header, indicating that the Lease Time will follow. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_LEASETIME 51 + + /** DHCP option list entry header, indicating that the DHCP message type constant will follow. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_MESSAGETYPE 53 + + /** DHCP option list entry header, indicating that the IP address of the DHCP server will follow. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_DHCPSERVER 54 + + /** DHCP option list entry header, used to pad out option data. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_PAD 0 + + /** DHCP option list entry header, indicating the end of option data. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_END 255 + + /** Message type constant, used in the DHCP option data field, requesting that a DHCP server offer an IP address. */ + #define DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_DISCOVER 1 + + /** Message type constant, used in the DHCP option data field, indicating that a DHCP server is offering an IP address. */ + #define DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_OFFER 2 + + /** Message type constant, used in the DHCP option data field, requesting that a DHCP server lease a given IP address. */ + #define DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_REQUEST 3 + + /** Message type constant, used in the DHCP option data field, declining an offered DHCP server IP address lease. */ + #define DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_DECLINE 4 + + /** Message type constant, used in the DHCP option data field, ACKing a host IP lease request. */ + #define DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_ACK 5 + + /** Message type constant, used in the DHCP option data field, NACKing a host IP lease request. */ + #define DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_NACK 6 + + /** Message type constant, used in the DHCP option data field, indicating that a host is releasing a leased IP address. */ + #define DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_RELEASE 7 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a DHCP packet inside an Ethernet frame. */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Operation; /**< DHCP operation, either DHCP_OP_BOOTREQUEST or DHCP_OP_BOOTREPLY */ + uint8_t HardwareType; /**< Hardware carrier type constant */ + uint8_t HardwareAddressLength; /**< Length in bytes of a hardware (MAC) address on the network */ + uint8_t Hops; /**< Number of hops required to reach the server, unused */ + + uint32_t TransactionID; /**< Unique ID of the DHCP packet, for positive matching between sent and received packets */ + + uint16_t ElapsedSeconds; /**< Elapsed seconds since the request was made */ + uint16_t Flags; /**< BOOTP packet flags */ + + IP_Address_t ClientIP; /**< Client IP address, if already leased an IP */ + IP_Address_t YourIP; /**< Client IP address */ + IP_Address_t NextServerIP; /**< Legacy BOOTP protocol field, unused for DHCP */ + IP_Address_t RelayAgentIP; /**< Legacy BOOTP protocol field, unused for DHCP */ + + uint8_t ClientHardwareAddress[16]; /**< Hardware (MAC) address of the client making a request to the DHCP server */ + uint8_t ServerHostnameString[64]; /**< Legacy BOOTP protocol field, unused for DHCP */ + uint8_t BootFileName[128]; /**< Legacy BOOTP protocol field, unused for DHCP */ + + uint32_t Cookie; /**< Magic BOOTP protocol cookie to indicate a valid packet */ + } DHCP_Header_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + int16_t DHCP_ProcessDHCPPacket(void* IPHeaderInStart, + void* DHCPHeaderInStart, + void* DHCPHeaderOutStart); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Ethernet.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Ethernet.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c28fa2336b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Ethernet.c @@ -0,0 +1,132 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Ethernet frame packet handling routines. This protocol handles the processing of raw Ethernet + * frames sent and received, deferring the processing of sub-packet protocols to the appropriate + * protocol handlers, such as DHCP or ARP. + */ + +#include "Ethernet.h" + +/** Constant for convenience when checking against or setting a MAC address to the virtual server MAC address. */ +const MAC_Address_t ServerMACAddress = {SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS}; + +/** Constant for convenience when checking against or setting an IP address to the virtual server IP address. */ +const IP_Address_t ServerIPAddress = {SERVER_IP_ADDRESS}; + +/** Constant for convenience when checking against or setting a MAC address to the broadcast MAC address. */ +const MAC_Address_t BroadcastMACAddress = {BROADCAST_MAC_ADDRESS}; + +/** Constant for convenience when checking against or setting a IP address to the broadcast IP address. */ +const IP_Address_t BroadcastIPAddress = {BROADCAST_IP_ADDRESS}; + +/** Constant for convenience when checking against or setting an IP address to the client (host) IP address. */ +const IP_Address_t ClientIPAddress = {CLIENT_IP_ADDRESS}; + + +/** Processes an incoming Ethernet frame, and writes the appropriate response to the output Ethernet + * frame buffer if the sub protocol handlers create a valid response. + */ +void Ethernet_ProcessPacket(Ethernet_Frame_Info_t* const FrameIN, + Ethernet_Frame_Info_t* const FrameOUT) +{ + DecodeEthernetFrameHeader(FrameIN->FrameData); + + /* Cast the incoming Ethernet frame to the Ethernet header type */ + Ethernet_Frame_Header_t* FrameINHeader = (Ethernet_Frame_Header_t*)&FrameIN->FrameData; + Ethernet_Frame_Header_t* FrameOUTHeader = (Ethernet_Frame_Header_t*)&FrameOUT->FrameData; + + int16_t RetSize = NO_RESPONSE; + + /* Ensure frame is addressed to either all (broadcast) or the virtual webserver, and is a type II frame */ + if ((MAC_COMPARE(&FrameINHeader->Destination, &ServerMACAddress) || + MAC_COMPARE(&FrameINHeader->Destination, &BroadcastMACAddress)) && + (SwapEndian_16(FrameIN->FrameLength) > ETHERNET_VER2_MINSIZE)) + { + /* Process the packet depending on its protocol */ + switch (SwapEndian_16(FrameINHeader->EtherType)) + { + case ETHERTYPE_ARP: + RetSize = ARP_ProcessARPPacket(&FrameIN->FrameData[sizeof(Ethernet_Frame_Header_t)], + &FrameOUT->FrameData[sizeof(Ethernet_Frame_Header_t)]); + break; + case ETHERTYPE_IPV4: + RetSize = IP_ProcessIPPacket(FrameIN, + &FrameIN->FrameData[sizeof(Ethernet_Frame_Header_t)], + &FrameOUT->FrameData[sizeof(Ethernet_Frame_Header_t)]); + break; + } + + /* Protocol processing routine has filled a response, complete the ethernet frame header */ + if (RetSize > 0) + { + /* Fill out the response Ethernet frame header */ + FrameOUTHeader->Source = ServerMACAddress; + FrameOUTHeader->Destination = FrameINHeader->Source; + FrameOUTHeader->EtherType = FrameINHeader->EtherType; + + /* Set the response length in the buffer and indicate that a response is ready to be sent */ + FrameOUT->FrameLength = (sizeof(Ethernet_Frame_Header_t) + RetSize); + } + } + + /* Check if the packet was processed */ + if (RetSize != NO_PROCESS) + { + /* Clear the frame buffer */ + FrameIN->FrameLength = 0; + } +} + +/** Calculates the appropriate ethernet checksum, consisting of the addition of the one's + * compliment of each word, complimented. + * + * \param[in] Data Pointer to the packet buffer data whose checksum must be calculated + * \param[in] Bytes Number of bytes in the data buffer to process + * + * \return A 16-bit Ethernet checksum value + */ +uint16_t Ethernet_Checksum16(void* Data, + uint16_t Bytes) +{ + uint16_t* Words = (uint16_t*)Data; + uint32_t Checksum = 0; + + for (uint16_t CurrWord = 0; CurrWord < (Bytes >> 1); CurrWord++) + Checksum += Words[CurrWord]; + + while (Checksum & 0xFFFF0000) + Checksum = ((Checksum & 0xFFFF) + (Checksum >> 16)); + + return ~Checksum; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Ethernet.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Ethernet.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9bdb71c8f6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Ethernet.h @@ -0,0 +1,101 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Ethernet.c. + */ + +#ifndef _ETHERNET_H_ +#define _ETHERNET_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include "EthernetProtocols.h" + #include "ProtocolDecoders.h" + #include "ICMP.h" + #include "TCP.h" + #include "UDP.h" + #include "DHCP.h" + #include "ARP.h" + #include "IP.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Physical MAC address of the network broadcast address. */ + #define BROADCAST_MAC_ADDRESS {0xFF, 0xFF, 0xFF, 0xFF, 0xFF, 0xFF} + + /** Performs a comparison between two MAC addresses, indicating if they are identical. + * + * \param[in] MAC1 First MAC address + * \param[in] MAC2 Second MAC address + * + * \return True if the addresses match, \c false otherwise + */ + #define MAC_COMPARE(MAC1, MAC2) (memcmp(MAC1, MAC2, sizeof(MAC_Address_t)) == 0) + + /** Minimum size of an Ethernet packet in bytes, to conform to the Ethernet V2 packet standard. */ + #define ETHERNET_VER2_MINSIZE 0x0600 + + /** Return value for all sub protocol handling routines, indicating that no response packet has been generated. */ + #define NO_RESPONSE 0 + + /** Return value for all sub protocol handling routines, indicating that the packet has not yet been handled. */ + #define NO_PROCESS -1 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for an Ethernet frame header. */ + typedef struct + { + MAC_Address_t Destination; /**< Physical MAC address of the packet recipient */ + MAC_Address_t Source; /**< Physics MAC address of the packet source */ + uint16_t EtherType; /**< Ethernet packet sub-protocol type, for Ethernet V2 packets */ + } Ethernet_Frame_Header_t; + + /* External Variables: */ + extern const MAC_Address_t ServerMACAddress; + extern const IP_Address_t ServerIPAddress; + extern const MAC_Address_t BroadcastMACAddress; + extern const IP_Address_t BroadcastIPAddress; + extern const IP_Address_t ClientIPAddress; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void Ethernet_ProcessPacket(Ethernet_Frame_Info_t* const FrameIN, + Ethernet_Frame_Info_t* const FrameOUT); + uint16_t Ethernet_Checksum16(void* Data, + uint16_t Bytes); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/EthernetProtocols.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/EthernetProtocols.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..51d3f32ee3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/EthernetProtocols.h @@ -0,0 +1,92 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * General Ethernet protocol constants and type defines, for use by + * all network protocol portions of the TCP/IP stack. + */ + +#ifndef _ETHERNET_PROTOCOLS_H_ +#define _ETHERNET_PROTOCOLS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Macros: */ + #define ETHERTYPE_IPV4 0x0800 + #define ETHERTYPE_ARP 0x0806 + #define ETHERTYPE_RARP 0x8035 + #define ETHERTYPE_APPLETALK 0x809b + #define ETHERTYPE_APPLETALKARP 0x80f3 + #define ETHERTYPE_IEEE8021Q 0x8100 + #define ETHERTYPE_NOVELLIPX 0x8137 + #define ETHERTYPE_NOVELL 0x8138 + #define ETHERTYPE_IPV6 0x86DD + #define ETHERTYPE_COBRANET 0x8819 + #define ETHERTYPE_PROVIDERBRIDGING 0x88a8 + #define ETHERTYPE_MPLSUNICAST 0x8847 + #define ETHERTYPE_MPLSMULTICAST 0x8848 + #define ETHERTYPE_PPPoEDISCOVERY 0x8863 + #define ETHERTYPE_PPPoESESSION 0x8864 + #define ETHERTYPE_EAPOVERLAN 0x888E + #define ETHERTYPE_HYPERSCSI 0x889A + #define ETHERTYPE_ATAOVERETHERNET 0x88A2 + #define ETHERTYPE_ETHERCAT 0x88A4 + #define ETHERTYPE_SERCOSIII 0x88CD + #define ETHERTYPE_CESoE 0x88D8 + #define ETHERTYPE_MACSECURITY 0x88E5 + #define ETHERTYPE_FIBRECHANNEL 0x8906 + #define ETHERTYPE_QINQ 0x9100 + #define ETHERTYPE_VLLT 0xCAFE + + #define PROTOCOL_ICMP 1 + #define PROTOCOL_IGMP 2 + #define PROTOCOL_TCP 6 + #define PROTOCOL_UDP 17 + #define PROTOCOL_OSPF 89 + #define PROTOCOL_SCTP 132 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for an Ethernet frame buffer data and information structure. */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t FrameData[ETHERNET_FRAME_SIZE_MAX]; /**< Ethernet frame contents. */ + uint16_t FrameLength; /**< Length in bytes of the Ethernet frame stored in the buffer. */ + } Ethernet_Frame_Info_t; + + /** Type define for a protocol IP address of a device on a network. */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Octets[4]; /**< Individual bytes of an IP address */ + } IP_Address_t; + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ICMP.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ICMP.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..24bc4b53fe --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ICMP.c @@ -0,0 +1,83 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packet handling routines. This protocol handles + * Echo requests from the host, to indicate a successful network connection between the host + * and the virtual server. + */ + +#include "ICMP.h" + +/** Processes an ICMP packet inside an Ethernet frame, and writes the appropriate response + * to the output Ethernet frame if the host is issuing a ICMP ECHO request. + * + * \param[in] FrameIN Pointer to the incoming Ethernet frame information structure + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of the incoming packet's ICMP header + * \param[out] OutDataStart Pointer to the start of the outgoing packet's ICMP header + * + * \return The number of bytes written to the out Ethernet frame if any, NO_RESPONSE otherwise + */ +int16_t ICMP_ProcessICMPPacket(Ethernet_Frame_Info_t* const FrameIN, + void* InDataStart, + void* OutDataStart) +{ + ICMP_Header_t* ICMPHeaderIN = (ICMP_Header_t*)InDataStart; + ICMP_Header_t* ICMPHeaderOUT = (ICMP_Header_t*)OutDataStart; + + DecodeICMPHeader(InDataStart); + + /* Determine if the ICMP packet is an echo request (ping) */ + if (ICMPHeaderIN->Type == ICMP_TYPE_ECHOREQUEST) + { + /* Fill out the ICMP response packet */ + ICMPHeaderOUT->Type = ICMP_TYPE_ECHOREPLY; + ICMPHeaderOUT->Code = 0; + ICMPHeaderOUT->Checksum = 0; + ICMPHeaderOUT->Id = ICMPHeaderIN->Id; + ICMPHeaderOUT->Sequence = ICMPHeaderIN->Sequence; + + intptr_t DataSize = FrameIN->FrameLength - ((((intptr_t)InDataStart + sizeof(ICMP_Header_t)) - (intptr_t)FrameIN->FrameData)); + + /* Copy the remaining payload to the response - echo requests should echo back any sent data */ + memmove(&((uint8_t*)OutDataStart)[sizeof(ICMP_Header_t)], + &((uint8_t*)InDataStart)[sizeof(ICMP_Header_t)], + DataSize); + + ICMPHeaderOUT->Checksum = Ethernet_Checksum16(ICMPHeaderOUT, (DataSize + sizeof(ICMP_Header_t))); + + /* Return the size of the response so far */ + return (DataSize + sizeof(ICMP_Header_t)); + } + + return NO_RESPONSE; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ICMP.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ICMP.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..594dfffb24 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ICMP.h @@ -0,0 +1,83 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ICMP.c. + */ + +#ifndef _ICMP_H_ +#define _ICMP_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "EthernetProtocols.h" + #include "Ethernet.h" + #include "ProtocolDecoders.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** ICMP message type constant, indicating an ICMP ECHO Reply message. */ + #define ICMP_TYPE_ECHOREPLY 0 + + /** ICMP message type constant, indicating a packet destination is unreachable. */ + #define ICMP_TYPE_DESTINATIONUNREACHABLE 3 + + /** ICMP message type constant, indicating an ICMP Source Quench message. */ + #define ICMP_TYPE_SOURCEQUENCH 4 + + /** ICMP message type constant, indicating an ICMP Redirect message. */ + #define ICMP_TYPE_REDIRECTMESSAGE 5 + + /** ICMP message type constant, indicating an ICMP ECHO Request message. */ + #define ICMP_TYPE_ECHOREQUEST 8 + + /** ICMP message type constant, indicating an ICMP Time Exceeded message. */ + #define ICMP_TYPE_TIMEEXCEEDED 11 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for an ICMP message header. */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Type; /**< ICMP message type, an \c ICMP_TYPE_* constant */ + uint8_t Code; /**< ICMP message code, indicating the message value */ + uint16_t Checksum; /**< Ethernet checksum of the ICMP message */ + uint16_t Id; /**< Id of the ICMP message */ + uint16_t Sequence; /**< Sequence number of the ICMP message, to link together message responses */ + } ICMP_Header_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + int16_t ICMP_ProcessICMPPacket(Ethernet_Frame_Info_t* const FrameIN, + void* InDataStart, + void* OutDataStart); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/IP.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/IP.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..05d4ebeeee --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/IP.c @@ -0,0 +1,116 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Internet Protocol (IP) packet handling routines. This protocol handles IP packets from the + * host which typically encapsulate other protocols such as ICMP, UDP and TCP. + */ + +#include "IP.h" + +/** Processes an IP packet inside an Ethernet frame, and writes the appropriate response + * to the output Ethernet frame if one is created by a sub-protocol handler. + * + * \param[in] FrameIN Pointer to the incoming Ethernet frame information structure + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of the incoming packet's IP header + * \param[out] OutDataStart Pointer to the start of the outgoing packet's IP header + * + * \return The number of bytes written to the out Ethernet frame if any, NO_RESPONSE if no + * response was generated, NO_PROCESS if the packet processing was deferred until the + * next Ethernet packet handler iteration + */ +int16_t IP_ProcessIPPacket(Ethernet_Frame_Info_t* const FrameIN, + void* InDataStart, + void* OutDataStart) +{ + DecodeIPHeader(InDataStart); + + IP_Header_t* IPHeaderIN = (IP_Header_t*)InDataStart; + IP_Header_t* IPHeaderOUT = (IP_Header_t*)OutDataStart; + + /* Header length is specified in number of longs in the packet header, convert to bytes */ + uint16_t HeaderLengthBytes = (IPHeaderIN->HeaderLength * sizeof(uint32_t)); + + int16_t RetSize = NO_RESPONSE; + + /* Check to ensure the IP packet is addressed to the virtual webserver's IP or the broadcast IP address */ + if (!(IP_COMPARE(&IPHeaderIN->DestinationAddress, &ServerIPAddress)) && + !(IP_COMPARE(&IPHeaderIN->DestinationAddress, &BroadcastIPAddress))) + { + return NO_RESPONSE; + } + + /* Pass off the IP payload to the appropriate protocol processing routine */ + switch (IPHeaderIN->Protocol) + { + case PROTOCOL_ICMP: + RetSize = ICMP_ProcessICMPPacket(FrameIN, + &((uint8_t*)InDataStart)[HeaderLengthBytes], + &((uint8_t*)OutDataStart)[sizeof(IP_Header_t)]); + break; + case PROTOCOL_TCP: + RetSize = TCP_ProcessTCPPacket(InDataStart, + &((uint8_t*)InDataStart)[HeaderLengthBytes], + &((uint8_t*)OutDataStart)[sizeof(IP_Header_t)]); + break; + case PROTOCOL_UDP: + RetSize = UDP_ProcessUDPPacket(InDataStart, + &((uint8_t*)InDataStart)[HeaderLengthBytes], + &((uint8_t*)OutDataStart)[sizeof(IP_Header_t)]); + break; + } + + /* Check to see if the protocol processing routine has filled out a response */ + if (RetSize > 0) + { + /* Fill out the response IP packet header */ + IPHeaderOUT->TotalLength = SwapEndian_16(sizeof(IP_Header_t) + RetSize); + IPHeaderOUT->TypeOfService = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->HeaderLength = (sizeof(IP_Header_t) / sizeof(uint32_t)); + IPHeaderOUT->Version = 4; + IPHeaderOUT->Flags = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->FragmentOffset = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->Identification = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->HeaderChecksum = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->Protocol = IPHeaderIN->Protocol; + IPHeaderOUT->TTL = DEFAULT_TTL; + IPHeaderOUT->SourceAddress = IPHeaderIN->DestinationAddress; + IPHeaderOUT->DestinationAddress = IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress; + + IPHeaderOUT->HeaderChecksum = Ethernet_Checksum16(IPHeaderOUT, sizeof(IP_Header_t)); + + /* Return the size of the response so far */ + return (sizeof(IP_Header_t) + RetSize); + } + + return RetSize; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/IP.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/IP.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0dd6db8a41 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/IP.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for IP.c. + */ + +#ifndef _IP_H_ +#define _IP_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "EthernetProtocols.h" + #include "Ethernet.h" + #include "ProtocolDecoders.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Protocol IP address of the broadcast address. */ + #define BROADCAST_IP_ADDRESS {0xFF, 0xFF, 0xFF, 0xFF} + + /** Default Time To Live (TTL) value for sent packets, indicating the maximum allowable hops until their destination + * is reached. + */ + #define DEFAULT_TTL 128 + + /** Performs a comparison between two IP addresses, indicating if they are identical. + * + * \param[in] IP1 First IP address + * \param[in] IP2 Second IP address + * + * \return True if the addresses match, \c false otherwise + */ + #define IP_COMPARE(IP1, IP2) (memcmp(IP1, IP2, sizeof(IP_Address_t)) == 0) + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define of an IP packet header. */ + typedef struct + { + unsigned HeaderLength : 4; /**< Total length of the packet header, in 4-byte blocks */ + unsigned Version : 4; /**< IP protocol version */ + uint8_t TypeOfService; /**< Special service type identifier, indicating delay/throughput/reliability levels */ + uint16_t TotalLength; /**< Total length of the IP packet, in bytes */ + + uint16_t Identification; /**< Identification value for identifying fragmented packets */ + unsigned FragmentOffset : 13; /**< Offset of this IP fragment */ + unsigned Flags : 3; /**< Fragment flags, to indicate if a packet is fragmented */ + + uint8_t TTL; /**< Maximum allowable number of hops to reach the packet destination */ + uint8_t Protocol; /**< Encapsulated protocol type */ + uint16_t HeaderChecksum; /**< Ethernet checksum of the IP header */ + + IP_Address_t SourceAddress; /**< Source protocol IP address of the packet */ + IP_Address_t DestinationAddress; /**< Destination protocol IP address of the packet */ + } IP_Header_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + int16_t IP_ProcessIPPacket(Ethernet_Frame_Info_t* const FrameIN, + void* InDataStart, + void* OutDataStart); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ProtocolDecoders.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ProtocolDecoders.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4c72f81b39 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ProtocolDecoders.c @@ -0,0 +1,277 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/* Protocol decoders for Ethernet, TCP, IP, ICMP and ARP. Each of these routines + accepts a header to the appropriate protocol and prints out pertinent information + on the packet through the serial port. + + To disable printing of a specific protocol, define the token NO_DECODE_{Protocol} + in the project makefile, and pass it to the compiler using the -D switch. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Protocol decoding routines, for the plain-text decoding of Ethernet frames for debugging purposes. + * Enabled protocol decoders will print incoming Ethernet frame contents through the USART in a human + * readable format. + * + * Note that the USART is a slow transmission medium, and will slow down packet processing considerably. + * Packet decoding routines can be disabled by defining NO_DECODE_{Protocol Name} in the project makefile + * and passing it to the compiler via the -D switch. + */ + +#include "ProtocolDecoders.h" + +/** Decodes an Ethernet frame header and prints its contents to through the USART in a human readable format. + * + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of an Ethernet frame of data + */ +void DecodeEthernetFrameHeader(void* InDataStart) +{ + #if !defined(NO_DECODE_ETHERNET) + Ethernet_Frame_Header_t* FrameHeader = (Ethernet_Frame_Header_t*)InDataStart; + + printf_P(PSTR("\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" ETHERNET\r\n")); + + if (!(MAC_COMPARE(&FrameHeader->Destination, &ServerMACAddress)) && + !(MAC_COMPARE(&FrameHeader->Destination, &BroadcastMACAddress))) + { + printf_P(PSTR(" + NOT ADDRESSED TO DEVICE\r\n")); + return; + } + + printf_P(PSTR(" + MAC Source : %02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X\r\n"), FrameHeader->Source.Octets[0], + FrameHeader->Source.Octets[1], + FrameHeader->Source.Octets[2], + FrameHeader->Source.Octets[3], + FrameHeader->Source.Octets[4], + FrameHeader->Source.Octets[5]); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + MAC Dest: %02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X\r\n"), FrameHeader->Destination.Octets[0], + FrameHeader->Destination.Octets[1], + FrameHeader->Destination.Octets[2], + FrameHeader->Destination.Octets[3], + FrameHeader->Destination.Octets[4], + FrameHeader->Destination.Octets[5]); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Protocol: 0x%04x\r\n"), SwapEndian_16(FrameHeader->EtherType)); + #endif +} + +/** Decodes an ARP header and prints its contents to through the USART in a human readable format. + * + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of an ARP packet header + */ +void DecodeARPHeader(void* InDataStart) +{ + #if !defined(NO_DECODE_ARP) + ARP_Header_t* ARPHeader = (ARP_Header_t*)InDataStart; + + printf_P(PSTR(" \\\r\n ARP\r\n")); + + if (!(IP_COMPARE(&ARPHeader->TPA, &ServerIPAddress)) && + !(MAC_COMPARE(&ARPHeader->THA, &ServerMACAddress))) + { + printf_P(PSTR(" + NOT ADDRESSED TO DEVICE\r\n")); + return; + } + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Protocol: %x\r\n"), SwapEndian_16(ARPHeader->ProtocolType)); + printf_P(PSTR(" + Operation: %u\r\n"), SwapEndian_16(ARPHeader->Operation)); + + if (SwapEndian_16(ARPHeader->ProtocolType) == ETHERTYPE_IPV4) + { + printf_P(PSTR(" + SHA MAC: %02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X\r\n"), ARPHeader->SHA.Octets[0], + ARPHeader->SHA.Octets[1], + ARPHeader->SHA.Octets[2], + ARPHeader->SHA.Octets[3], + ARPHeader->SHA.Octets[4], + ARPHeader->SHA.Octets[5]); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + SPA IP: %u.%u.%u.%u\r\n"), ARPHeader->SPA.Octets[0], + ARPHeader->SPA.Octets[1], + ARPHeader->SPA.Octets[2], + ARPHeader->SPA.Octets[3]); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + THA MAC: %02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X\r\n"), ARPHeader->THA.Octets[0], + ARPHeader->THA.Octets[1], + ARPHeader->THA.Octets[2], + ARPHeader->THA.Octets[3], + ARPHeader->THA.Octets[4], + ARPHeader->THA.Octets[5]); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + TPA IP: %u.%u.%u.%u\r\n"), ARPHeader->TPA.Octets[0], + ARPHeader->TPA.Octets[1], + ARPHeader->TPA.Octets[2], + ARPHeader->TPA.Octets[3]); + } + #endif +} + +/** Decodes an IP header and prints its contents to through the USART in a human readable format. + * + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of an IP packet header + */ +void DecodeIPHeader(void* InDataStart) +{ + #if !defined(NO_DECODE_IP) + IP_Header_t* IPHeader = (IP_Header_t*)InDataStart; + + uint16_t HeaderLengthBytes = (IPHeader->HeaderLength * sizeof(uint32_t)); + + printf_P(PSTR(" \\\r\n IP\r\n")); + + if (!(IP_COMPARE(&IPHeader->DestinationAddress, &ServerIPAddress))) + { + printf_P(PSTR(" + NOT ADDRESSED TO DEVICE\r\n")); + return; + } + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Header Length: %u Bytes\r\n"), HeaderLengthBytes); + printf_P(PSTR(" + Packet Version: %u\r\n"), IPHeader->Version); + printf_P(PSTR(" + Total Length: %u\r\n"), SwapEndian_16(IPHeader->TotalLength)); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Protocol: %u\r\n"), IPHeader->Protocol); + printf_P(PSTR(" + TTL: %u\r\n"), IPHeader->TTL); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + IP Src: %u.%u.%u.%u\r\n"), IPHeader->SourceAddress.Octets[0], + IPHeader->SourceAddress.Octets[1], + IPHeader->SourceAddress.Octets[2], + IPHeader->SourceAddress.Octets[3]); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + IP Dst: %u.%u.%u.%u\r\n"), IPHeader->DestinationAddress.Octets[0], + IPHeader->DestinationAddress.Octets[1], + IPHeader->DestinationAddress.Octets[2], + IPHeader->DestinationAddress.Octets[3]); + #endif +} + +/** Decodes an ICMP header and prints its contents to through the USART in a human readable format. + * + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of an ICMP packet header + */ +void DecodeICMPHeader(void* InDataStart) +{ + #if !defined(NO_DECODE_ICMP) + ICMP_Header_t* ICMPHeader = (ICMP_Header_t*)InDataStart; + + printf_P(PSTR(" \\\r\n ICMP\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Type: %u\r\n"), ICMPHeader->Type); + printf_P(PSTR(" + Code: %u\r\n"), ICMPHeader->Code); + #endif +} + +/** Decodes a TCP header and prints its contents to through the USART in a human readable format. + * + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of a TCP packet header + */ +void DecodeTCPHeader(void* InDataStart) +{ + #if !defined(NO_DECODE_TCP) + TCP_Header_t* TCPHeader = (TCP_Header_t*)InDataStart; + + uint16_t HeaderLengthBytes = (TCPHeader->DataOffset * sizeof(uint32_t)); + + printf_P(PSTR(" \\\r\n TCP\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Header Length: %u Bytes\r\n"), HeaderLengthBytes); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Source Port: %u\r\n"), SwapEndian_16(TCPHeader->SourcePort)); + printf_P(PSTR(" + Destination Port: %u\r\n"), SwapEndian_16(TCPHeader->DestinationPort)); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Sequence Number: %lu\r\n"), SwapEndian_32(TCPHeader->SequenceNumber)); + printf_P(PSTR(" + Acknowledgment Number: %lu\r\n"), SwapEndian_32(TCPHeader->AcknowledgmentNumber)); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Flags: 0x%02X\r\n"), TCPHeader->Flags); + + if (TCP_GetPortState(TCPHeader->DestinationPort) == TCP_Port_Closed) + printf_P(PSTR(" + NOT LISTENING ON DESTINATION PORT\r\n")); + #endif +} + +/** Decodes an UDP header and prints its contents to through the USART in a human readable format. + * + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of a UDP packet header + */ +void DecodeUDPHeader(void* InDataStart) +{ + #if !defined(NO_DECODE_UDP) + UDP_Header_t* UDPHeader = (UDP_Header_t*)InDataStart; + + printf_P(PSTR(" \\\r\n UDP\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Source Port: %u\r\n"), SwapEndian_16(UDPHeader->SourcePort)); + printf_P(PSTR(" + Destination Port: %u\r\n"), SwapEndian_16(UDPHeader->DestinationPort)); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Data Length: %d\r\n"), SwapEndian_16(UDPHeader->Length)); + #endif +} + +/** Decodes an DHCP header and prints its contents to through the USART in a human readable format. + * + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of a DHCP packet header + */ +void DecodeDHCPHeader(void* InDataStart) +{ + #if !defined(NO_DECODE_DHCP) + uint8_t* DHCPOptions = ((uint8_t*)InDataStart + sizeof(DHCP_Header_t)); + + printf_P(PSTR(" \\\r\n DHCP\r\n")); + + while (DHCPOptions[0] != DHCP_OPTION_END) + { + if (DHCPOptions[0] == DHCP_OPTION_MESSAGETYPE) + { + switch (DHCPOptions[2]) + { + case DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_DISCOVER: + printf_P(PSTR(" + DISCOVER\r\n")); + break; + case DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_REQUEST: + printf_P(PSTR(" + REQUEST\r\n")); + break; + case DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_RELEASE: + printf_P(PSTR(" + RELEASE\r\n")); + break; + case DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_DECLINE: + printf_P(PSTR(" + DECLINE\r\n")); + break; + } + } + + DHCPOptions += ((DHCPOptions[0] == DHCP_OPTION_PAD) ? 1 : (DHCPOptions[1] + 2)); + } + + #endif +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ProtocolDecoders.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ProtocolDecoders.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..77a50f02f4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ProtocolDecoders.h @@ -0,0 +1,60 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ProtocolDecoders.c. + */ + +#ifndef _PROTOCOL_DECODERS_H_ +#define _PROTOCOL_DECODERS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + + #include "EthernetProtocols.h" + #include "Ethernet.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void DecodeEthernetFrameHeader(void* InDataStart); + void DecodeARPHeader(void* InDataStart); + void DecodeIPHeader(void* InDataStart); + void DecodeICMPHeader(void* InDataStart); + void DecodeTCPHeader(void* InDataStart); + void DecodeUDPHeader(void* InDataStart); + void DecodeDHCPHeader(void* InDataStart); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/TCP.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/TCP.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dcc527aa97 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/TCP.c @@ -0,0 +1,632 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Transmission Control Protocol (TCP) packet handling routines. This protocol handles the reliable in-order transmission + * and reception of packets to and from devices on a network, to "ports" on the device. It is used in situations where data + * delivery must be reliable and correct, e.g. HTTP, TELNET and most other non-streaming protocols. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_TCP_C +#include "TCP.h" + +/** Port state table array. This contains the current status of TCP ports in the device. To save on space, only open ports are + * stored - closed ports may be overwritten at any time, and the system will assume any ports not present in the array are closed. This + * allows for MAX_OPEN_TCP_PORTS to be less than the number of ports used by the application if desired. + */ +TCP_PortState_t PortStateTable[MAX_OPEN_TCP_PORTS]; + +/** Connection state table array. This contains the current status of TCP connections in the device. To save on space, only active + * (non-closed) connections are stored - closed connections may be overwritten at any time, and the system will assume any connections + * not present in the array are closed. + */ +TCP_ConnectionState_t ConnectionStateTable[MAX_TCP_CONNECTIONS]; + + +/** Task to handle the calling of each registered application's callback function, to process and generate TCP packets at the application + * level. If an application produces a response, this task constructs the appropriate Ethernet frame and places it into the Ethernet OUT + * buffer for later transmission. + */ +void TCP_TCPTask(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + Ethernet_Frame_Info_t* const FrameOUT) +{ + /* Run each application in sequence, to process incoming and generate outgoing packets */ + for (uint8_t CSTableEntry = 0; CSTableEntry < MAX_TCP_CONNECTIONS; CSTableEntry++) + { + /* Find the corresponding port entry in the port table */ + for (uint8_t PTableEntry = 0; PTableEntry < MAX_OPEN_TCP_PORTS; PTableEntry++) + { + /* Run the application handler for the port */ + if ((PortStateTable[PTableEntry].Port == ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Port) && + (PortStateTable[PTableEntry].State == TCP_Port_Open)) + { + PortStateTable[PTableEntry].ApplicationHandler(&ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry], + &ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info.Buffer); + } + } + } + + /* Bail out early if there is already a frame waiting to be sent in the Ethernet OUT buffer */ + if (FrameOUT->FrameLength) + return; + + /* Send response packets from each application as the TCP packet buffers are filled by the applications */ + for (uint8_t CSTableEntry = 0; CSTableEntry < MAX_TCP_CONNECTIONS; CSTableEntry++) + { + /* For each completely received packet, pass it along to the listening application */ + if ((ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info.Buffer.Direction == TCP_PACKETDIR_OUT) && + (ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info.Buffer.Ready)) + { + Ethernet_Frame_Header_t* FrameOUTHeader = (Ethernet_Frame_Header_t*)&FrameOUT->FrameData; + IP_Header_t* IPHeaderOUT = (IP_Header_t*)&FrameOUT->FrameData[sizeof(Ethernet_Frame_Header_t)]; + TCP_Header_t* TCPHeaderOUT = (TCP_Header_t*)&FrameOUT->FrameData[sizeof(Ethernet_Frame_Header_t) + + sizeof(IP_Header_t)]; + void* TCPDataOUT = &FrameOUT->FrameData[sizeof(Ethernet_Frame_Header_t) + + sizeof(IP_Header_t) + + sizeof(TCP_Header_t)]; + + uint16_t PacketSize = ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info.Buffer.Length; + + /* Fill out the TCP data */ + TCPHeaderOUT->SourcePort = ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Port; + TCPHeaderOUT->DestinationPort = ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemotePort; + TCPHeaderOUT->SequenceNumber = SwapEndian_32(ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info.SequenceNumberOut); + TCPHeaderOUT->AcknowledgmentNumber = SwapEndian_32(ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info.SequenceNumberIn); + TCPHeaderOUT->DataOffset = (sizeof(TCP_Header_t) / sizeof(uint32_t)); + TCPHeaderOUT->WindowSize = SwapEndian_16(TCP_WINDOW_SIZE); + + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = TCP_FLAG_ACK; + TCPHeaderOUT->UrgentPointer = 0; + TCPHeaderOUT->Checksum = 0; + TCPHeaderOUT->Reserved = 0; + + memcpy(TCPDataOUT, ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info.Buffer.Data, PacketSize); + + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info.SequenceNumberOut += PacketSize; + + TCPHeaderOUT->Checksum = TCP_Checksum16(TCPHeaderOUT, &ServerIPAddress, + &ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemoteAddress, + (sizeof(TCP_Header_t) + PacketSize)); + + PacketSize += sizeof(TCP_Header_t); + + /* Fill out the response IP header */ + IPHeaderOUT->TotalLength = SwapEndian_16(sizeof(IP_Header_t) + PacketSize); + IPHeaderOUT->TypeOfService = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->HeaderLength = (sizeof(IP_Header_t) / sizeof(uint32_t)); + IPHeaderOUT->Version = 4; + IPHeaderOUT->Flags = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->FragmentOffset = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->Identification = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->HeaderChecksum = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->Protocol = PROTOCOL_TCP; + IPHeaderOUT->TTL = DEFAULT_TTL; + IPHeaderOUT->SourceAddress = ServerIPAddress; + IPHeaderOUT->DestinationAddress = ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemoteAddress; + + IPHeaderOUT->HeaderChecksum = Ethernet_Checksum16(IPHeaderOUT, sizeof(IP_Header_t)); + + PacketSize += sizeof(IP_Header_t); + + /* Fill out the response Ethernet frame header */ + FrameOUTHeader->Source = ServerMACAddress; + FrameOUTHeader->Destination = (MAC_Address_t){{0x02, 0x00, 0x02, 0x00, 0x02, 0x00}}; + FrameOUTHeader->EtherType = SwapEndian_16(ETHERTYPE_IPV4); + + PacketSize += sizeof(Ethernet_Frame_Header_t); + + /* Set the response length in the buffer and indicate that a response is ready to be sent */ + FrameOUT->FrameLength = PacketSize; + + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info.Buffer.Ready = false; + + break; + } + } +} + +/** Initializes the TCP protocol handler, clearing the port and connection state tables. This must be called before TCP packets are + * processed. + */ +void TCP_Init(void) +{ + /* Initialize the port state table with all CLOSED entries */ + for (uint8_t PTableEntry = 0; PTableEntry < MAX_OPEN_TCP_PORTS; PTableEntry++) + PortStateTable[PTableEntry].State = TCP_Port_Closed; + + /* Initialize the connection table with all CLOSED entries */ + for (uint8_t CSTableEntry = 0; CSTableEntry < MAX_TCP_CONNECTIONS; CSTableEntry++) + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].State = TCP_Connection_Closed; +} + +/** Sets the state and callback handler of the given port, specified in big endian to the given state. + * + * \param[in] Port Port whose state and callback function to set, specified in big endian + * \param[in] State New state of the port, a value from the \ref TCP_PortStates_t enum + * \param[in] Handler Application callback handler for the port + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the port state was set, \c false otherwise (no more space in the port state table) + */ +bool TCP_SetPortState(const uint16_t Port, + const uint8_t State, + void (*Handler)(TCP_ConnectionState_t*, TCP_ConnectionBuffer_t*)) +{ + /* Note, Port number should be specified in BIG endian to simplify network code */ + + /* Check to see if the port entry is already in the port state table */ + for (uint8_t PTableEntry = 0; PTableEntry < MAX_OPEN_TCP_PORTS; PTableEntry++) + { + /* Find existing entry for the port in the table, update it if found */ + if (PortStateTable[PTableEntry].Port == Port) + { + PortStateTable[PTableEntry].State = State; + PortStateTable[PTableEntry].ApplicationHandler = Handler; + return true; + } + } + + /* Check if trying to open the port -- if so we need to find an unused (closed) entry and replace it */ + if (State == TCP_Port_Open) + { + for (uint8_t PTableEntry = 0; PTableEntry < MAX_OPEN_TCP_PORTS; PTableEntry++) + { + /* Find a closed port entry in the table, change it to the given port and state */ + if (PortStateTable[PTableEntry].State == TCP_Port_Closed) + { + PortStateTable[PTableEntry].Port = Port; + PortStateTable[PTableEntry].State = State; + PortStateTable[PTableEntry].ApplicationHandler = Handler; + return true; + } + } + + /* Port not in table and no room to add it, return failure */ + return false; + } + else + { + /* Port not in table but trying to close it, so operation successful */ + return true; + } +} + +/** Retrieves the current state of a given TCP port, specified in big endian. + * + * \param[in] Port TCP port whose state is to be retrieved, given in big-endian + * + * \return A value from the \ref TCP_PortStates_t enum + */ +uint8_t TCP_GetPortState(const uint16_t Port) +{ + /* Note, Port number should be specified in BIG endian to simplify network code */ + + for (uint8_t PTableEntry = 0; PTableEntry < MAX_OPEN_TCP_PORTS; PTableEntry++) + { + /* Find existing entry for the port in the table, return the port status if found */ + if (PortStateTable[PTableEntry].Port == Port) + return PortStateTable[PTableEntry].State; + } + + /* Port not in table, assume closed */ + return TCP_Port_Closed; +} + +/** Sets the connection state of the given port, remote address and remote port to the given TCP connection state. If the + * connection exists in the connection state table it is updated, otherwise it is created if possible. + * + * \param[in] Port TCP port of the connection on the device, specified in big endian + * \param[in] RemoteAddress Remote protocol IP address of the connected device + * \param[in] RemotePort TCP port of the remote device in the connection, specified in big endian + * \param[in] State TCP connection state, a value from the \ref TCP_ConnectionStates_t enum + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the connection was updated or created, \c false otherwise (no more space in the connection state table) + */ +bool TCP_SetConnectionState(const uint16_t Port, + const IP_Address_t* RemoteAddress, + const uint16_t RemotePort, + const uint8_t State) +{ + /* Note, Port number should be specified in BIG endian to simplify network code */ + + for (uint8_t CSTableEntry = 0; CSTableEntry < MAX_TCP_CONNECTIONS; CSTableEntry++) + { + /* Find port entry in the table */ + if ((ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Port == Port) && + IP_COMPARE(&ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemoteAddress, RemoteAddress) && + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemotePort == RemotePort) + { + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].State = State; + return true; + } + } + + for (uint8_t CSTableEntry = 0; CSTableEntry < MAX_TCP_CONNECTIONS; CSTableEntry++) + { + /* Find empty entry in the table */ + if (ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].State == TCP_Connection_Closed) + { + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Port = Port; + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemoteAddress = *RemoteAddress; + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemotePort = RemotePort; + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].State = State; + return true; + } + } + + return false; +} + +/** Retrieves the current state of a given TCP connection to a host. + * + * \param[in] Port TCP port on the device in the connection, specified in big endian + * \param[in] RemoteAddress Remote protocol IP address of the connected host + * \param[in] RemotePort Remote TCP port of the connected host, specified in big endian + * + * \return A value from the \ref TCP_ConnectionStates_t enum + */ +uint8_t TCP_GetConnectionState(const uint16_t Port, + const IP_Address_t* RemoteAddress, + const uint16_t RemotePort) +{ + /* Note, Port number should be specified in BIG endian to simplify network code */ + + for (uint8_t CSTableEntry = 0; CSTableEntry < MAX_TCP_CONNECTIONS; CSTableEntry++) + { + /* Find port entry in the table */ + if ((ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Port == Port) && + IP_COMPARE(&ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemoteAddress, RemoteAddress) && + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemotePort == RemotePort) + + { + return ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].State; + } + } + + return TCP_Connection_Closed; +} + +/** Retrieves the connection info structure of a given connection to a host. + * + * \param[in] Port TCP port on the device in the connection, specified in big endian + * \param[in] RemoteAddress Remote protocol IP address of the connected host + * \param[in] RemotePort Remote TCP port of the connected host, specified in big endian + * + * \return ConnectionInfo structure of the connection if found, NULL otherwise + */ +TCP_ConnectionInfo_t* TCP_GetConnectionInfo(const uint16_t Port, + const IP_Address_t* RemoteAddress, + const uint16_t RemotePort) +{ + /* Note, Port number should be specified in BIG endian to simplify network code */ + + for (uint8_t CSTableEntry = 0; CSTableEntry < MAX_TCP_CONNECTIONS; CSTableEntry++) + { + /* Find port entry in the table */ + if ((ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Port == Port) && + IP_COMPARE(&ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemoteAddress, RemoteAddress) && + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemotePort == RemotePort) + { + return &ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info; + } + } + + return NULL; +} + +/** Processes a TCP packet inside an Ethernet frame, and writes the appropriate response + * to the output Ethernet frame if one is created by a application handler. + * + * \param[in] IPHeaderInStart Pointer to the start of the incoming packet's IP header + * \param[in] TCPHeaderInStart Pointer to the start of the incoming packet's TCP header + * \param[out] TCPHeaderOutStart Pointer to the start of the outgoing packet's TCP header + * + * \return The number of bytes written to the out Ethernet frame if any, NO_RESPONSE if no + * response was generated, NO_PROCESS if the packet processing was deferred until the + * next Ethernet packet handler iteration + */ +int16_t TCP_ProcessTCPPacket(void* IPHeaderInStart, + void* TCPHeaderInStart, + void* TCPHeaderOutStart) +{ + IP_Header_t* IPHeaderIN = (IP_Header_t*)IPHeaderInStart; + TCP_Header_t* TCPHeaderIN = (TCP_Header_t*)TCPHeaderInStart; + TCP_Header_t* TCPHeaderOUT = (TCP_Header_t*)TCPHeaderOutStart; + + TCP_ConnectionInfo_t* ConnectionInfo; + + DecodeTCPHeader(TCPHeaderInStart); + + bool PacketResponse = false; + + /* Check if the destination port is open and allows incoming connections */ + if (TCP_GetPortState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort) == TCP_Port_Open) + { + /* Detect SYN from host to start a connection */ + if (TCPHeaderIN->Flags & TCP_FLAG_SYN) + TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_Listen); + + /* Detect RST from host to abort existing connection */ + if (TCPHeaderIN->Flags & TCP_FLAG_RST) + { + if (TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_Closed)) + { + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = (TCP_FLAG_RST | TCP_FLAG_ACK); + PacketResponse = true; + } + } + else + { + /* Process the incoming TCP packet based on the current connection state for the sender and port */ + switch (TCP_GetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort)) + { + case TCP_Connection_Listen: + if (TCPHeaderIN->Flags == TCP_FLAG_SYN) + { + /* SYN connection starts a connection with a peer */ + if (TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_SYNReceived)) + { + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = (TCP_FLAG_SYN | TCP_FLAG_ACK); + + ConnectionInfo = TCP_GetConnectionInfo(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort); + + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberIn = (SwapEndian_32(TCPHeaderIN->SequenceNumber) + 1); + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberOut = 0; + ConnectionInfo->Buffer.InUse = false; + } + else + { + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = TCP_FLAG_RST; + } + + PacketResponse = true; + } + + break; + case TCP_Connection_SYNReceived: + if (TCPHeaderIN->Flags == TCP_FLAG_ACK) + { + /* ACK during the connection process completes the connection to a peer */ + + TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_Established); + + ConnectionInfo = TCP_GetConnectionInfo(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort); + + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberOut++; + } + + break; + case TCP_Connection_Established: + if (TCPHeaderIN->Flags == (TCP_FLAG_FIN | TCP_FLAG_ACK)) + { + /* FIN ACK when connected to a peer starts the finalization process */ + + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = (TCP_FLAG_FIN | TCP_FLAG_ACK); + PacketResponse = true; + + TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_CloseWait); + + ConnectionInfo = TCP_GetConnectionInfo(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort); + + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberIn++; + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberOut++; + } + else if ((TCPHeaderIN->Flags == TCP_FLAG_ACK) || (TCPHeaderIN->Flags == (TCP_FLAG_ACK | TCP_FLAG_PSH))) + { + ConnectionInfo = TCP_GetConnectionInfo(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort); + + /* Check if the buffer is currently in use either by a buffered data to send, or receive */ + if ((ConnectionInfo->Buffer.InUse == false) && (ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Ready == false)) + { + ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Direction = TCP_PACKETDIR_IN; + ConnectionInfo->Buffer.InUse = true; + ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Length = 0; + } + + /* Check if the buffer has been claimed by us to read in data from the peer */ + if ((ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Direction == TCP_PACKETDIR_IN) && + (ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Length != TCP_WINDOW_SIZE)) + { + uint16_t IPOffset = (IPHeaderIN->HeaderLength * sizeof(uint32_t)); + uint16_t TCPOffset = (TCPHeaderIN->DataOffset * sizeof(uint32_t)); + uint16_t DataLength = (SwapEndian_16(IPHeaderIN->TotalLength) - IPOffset - TCPOffset); + + /* Copy the packet data into the buffer */ + memcpy(&ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Data[ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Length], + &((uint8_t*)TCPHeaderInStart)[TCPOffset], + DataLength); + + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberIn += DataLength; + ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Length += DataLength; + + /* Check if the buffer is full or if the PSH flag is set, if so indicate buffer ready */ + if ((!(TCP_WINDOW_SIZE - ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Length)) || (TCPHeaderIN->Flags & TCP_FLAG_PSH)) + { + ConnectionInfo->Buffer.InUse = false; + ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Ready = true; + + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = TCP_FLAG_ACK; + PacketResponse = true; + } + } + else + { + /* Buffer is currently in use by the application, defer processing of the incoming packet */ + return NO_PROCESS; + } + } + + break; + case TCP_Connection_Closing: + ConnectionInfo = TCP_GetConnectionInfo(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort); + + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = (TCP_FLAG_ACK | TCP_FLAG_FIN); + PacketResponse = true; + + ConnectionInfo->Buffer.InUse = false; + + TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_FINWait1); + + break; + case TCP_Connection_FINWait1: + if (TCPHeaderIN->Flags == (TCP_FLAG_FIN | TCP_FLAG_ACK)) + { + ConnectionInfo = TCP_GetConnectionInfo(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort); + + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = TCP_FLAG_ACK; + PacketResponse = true; + + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberIn++; + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberOut++; + + TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_Closed); + } + else if (TCPHeaderIN->Flags == TCP_FLAG_ACK) + { + TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_FINWait2); + } + + break; + case TCP_Connection_FINWait2: + if (TCPHeaderIN->Flags == (TCP_FLAG_FIN | TCP_FLAG_ACK)) + { + ConnectionInfo = TCP_GetConnectionInfo(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort); + + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = TCP_FLAG_ACK; + PacketResponse = true; + + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberIn++; + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberOut++; + + TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_Closed); + } + + break; + case TCP_Connection_CloseWait: + if (TCPHeaderIN->Flags == TCP_FLAG_ACK) + { + TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_Closed); + } + + break; + } + } + } + else + { + /* Port is not open, indicate via a RST/ACK response to the sender */ + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = (TCP_FLAG_RST | TCP_FLAG_ACK); + PacketResponse = true; + } + + /* Check if we need to respond to the sent packet */ + if (PacketResponse) + { + ConnectionInfo = TCP_GetConnectionInfo(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort); + + TCPHeaderOUT->SourcePort = TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort; + TCPHeaderOUT->DestinationPort = TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort; + TCPHeaderOUT->SequenceNumber = SwapEndian_32(ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberOut); + TCPHeaderOUT->AcknowledgmentNumber = SwapEndian_32(ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberIn); + TCPHeaderOUT->DataOffset = (sizeof(TCP_Header_t) / sizeof(uint32_t)); + + if (!(ConnectionInfo->Buffer.InUse)) + TCPHeaderOUT->WindowSize = SwapEndian_16(TCP_WINDOW_SIZE); + else + TCPHeaderOUT->WindowSize = SwapEndian_16(TCP_WINDOW_SIZE - ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Length); + + TCPHeaderOUT->UrgentPointer = 0; + TCPHeaderOUT->Checksum = 0; + TCPHeaderOUT->Reserved = 0; + + TCPHeaderOUT->Checksum = TCP_Checksum16(TCPHeaderOUT, &IPHeaderIN->DestinationAddress, + &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, sizeof(TCP_Header_t)); + + return sizeof(TCP_Header_t); + } + + return NO_RESPONSE; +} + +/** Calculates the appropriate TCP checksum, consisting of the addition of the one's compliment of each word, + * complimented. + * + * \param[in] TCPHeaderOutStart Pointer to the start of the packet's outgoing TCP header + * \param[in] SourceAddress Source protocol IP address of the outgoing IP header + * \param[in] DestinationAddress Destination protocol IP address of the outgoing IP header + * \param[in] TCPOutSize Size in bytes of the TCP data header and payload + * + * \return A 16-bit TCP checksum value + */ +static uint16_t TCP_Checksum16(void* TCPHeaderOutStart, + const IP_Address_t* SourceAddress, + const IP_Address_t* DestinationAddress, + uint16_t TCPOutSize) +{ + uint32_t Checksum = 0; + + /* TCP/IP checksums are the addition of the one's compliment of each word including the IP pseudo-header, + complimented */ + + Checksum += ((uint16_t*)SourceAddress)[0]; + Checksum += ((uint16_t*)SourceAddress)[1]; + Checksum += ((uint16_t*)DestinationAddress)[0]; + Checksum += ((uint16_t*)DestinationAddress)[1]; + Checksum += SwapEndian_16(PROTOCOL_TCP); + Checksum += SwapEndian_16(TCPOutSize); + + for (uint16_t CurrWord = 0; CurrWord < (TCPOutSize >> 1); CurrWord++) + Checksum += ((uint16_t*)TCPHeaderOutStart)[CurrWord]; + + if (TCPOutSize & 0x01) + Checksum += (((uint16_t*)TCPHeaderOutStart)[TCPOutSize >> 1] & 0x00FF); + + while (Checksum & 0xFFFF0000) + Checksum = ((Checksum & 0xFFFF) + (Checksum >> 16)); + + return ~Checksum; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/TCP.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/TCP.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b8eb4cfa1b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/TCP.h @@ -0,0 +1,260 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for TCP.c. + */ + +#ifndef _TCP_H_ +#define _TCP_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include "EthernetProtocols.h" + #include "Ethernet.h" + #include "ProtocolDecoders.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Maximum number of TCP ports which can be open at the one time. */ + #define MAX_OPEN_TCP_PORTS 1 + + /** Maximum number of TCP connections which can be sustained at the one time. */ + #define MAX_TCP_CONNECTIONS 3 + + /** TCP window size, giving the maximum number of bytes which can be buffered at the one time. */ + #define TCP_WINDOW_SIZE 512 + + /** Port number for HTTP transmissions. */ + #define TCP_PORT_HTTP SwapEndian_16(80) + + /** Data direction indicator for a TCP application buffer, indicating data from host-to-device. */ + #define TCP_PACKETDIR_IN false + + /** Data direction indicator for a TCP application buffer, indicating data from device-to-host. */ + #define TCP_PACKETDIR_OUT true + + /** Congestion Window Reduced TCP flag mask. */ + #define TCP_FLAG_CWR (1 << 7) + + /** Explicit Congestion Notification TCP flag mask. */ + #define TCP_FLAG_ECE (1 << 6) + + /** Urgent TCP flag mask. */ + #define TCP_FLAG_URG (1 << 5) + + /** Data Acknowledge TCP flag mask. */ + #define TCP_FLAG_ACK (1 << 4) + + /** Data Push TCP flag mask. */ + #define TCP_FLAG_PSH (1 << 3) + + /** Reset TCP flag mask. */ + #define TCP_FLAG_RST (1 << 2) + + /** Synchronize TCP flag mask. */ + #define TCP_FLAG_SYN (1 << 1) + + /** Connection Finalize TCP flag mask. */ + #define TCP_FLAG_FIN (1 << 0) + + /** Application macro: Determines if the given application buffer contains a packet received from the host + * + * \param[in] Buffer Application buffer to check + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the buffer contains a packet from the host, \c false otherwise + */ + #define TCP_APP_HAS_RECEIVED_PACKET(Buffer) (Buffer->Ready && (Buffer->Direction == TCP_PACKETDIR_IN)) + + /** Application macro: Indicates if the application buffer is currently locked by the application for device-to-host transfers. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Application buffer to check + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the buffer has been captured by the application for device-to-host transmissions, \c false otherwise + */ + #define TCP_APP_HAVE_CAPTURED_BUFFER(Buffer) (!(Buffer->Ready) && Buffer->InUse && (Buffer->Direction == TCP_PACKETDIR_OUT)) + + /** Application macro: Indicates if the application can lock the buffer for multiple continued device-to-host transmissions. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Application buffer to check + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the buffer may be captured by the application for device-to-host transmissions, \c false otherwise + */ + #define TCP_APP_CAN_CAPTURE_BUFFER(Buffer) Buffer->InUse + + /** Application macro: Captures the application buffer, locking it for device-to-host transmissions only. This should be + * performed when the application needs to transmit several packets worth of data in succession with no interruptions from the host. + * + * \pre The application must check that the buffer can be locked first using TCP_APP_CAN_CAPTURE_BUFFER(). + * + * \param[in] Buffer Application buffer to lock + */ + #define TCP_APP_CAPTURE_BUFFER(Buffer) do { Buffer->Direction = TCP_PACKETDIR_OUT; Buffer->InUse = true; } while (0) + + /** Application macro: Releases a captured application buffer, allowing for host-to-device packets to be received. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Application buffer to release + */ + #define TCP_APP_RELEASE_BUFFER(Buffer) do { Buffer->InUse = false; } while (0) + + /** Application macro: Sends the contents of the given application buffer to the host. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Application buffer to send + * \param[in] Len Length of data contained in the buffer + */ + #define TCP_APP_SEND_BUFFER(Buffer, Len) do { Buffer->Direction = TCP_PACKETDIR_OUT; Buffer->Length = Len; Buffer->Ready = true; } while (0) + + /** Application macro: Clears the application buffer, ready for a packet to be written to it. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Application buffer to clear + */ + #define TCP_APP_CLEAR_BUFFER(Buffer) do { Buffer->Ready = false; Buffer->Length = 0; } while (0) + + /** Application macro: Closes an open connection to a host. + * + * \param[in] Connection Open TCP connection to close + */ + #define TCP_APP_CLOSECONNECTION(Connection) do { Connection->State = TCP_Connection_Closing; } while (0) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for possible TCP port states. */ + enum TCP_PortStates_t + { + TCP_Port_Closed = 0, /**< TCP port closed, no connections to a host may be made on this port. */ + TCP_Port_Open = 1, /**< TCP port open, connections to a host may be made on this port. */ + }; + + /** Enum for possible TCP connection states. */ + enum TCP_ConnectionStates_t + { + TCP_Connection_Listen = 0, /**< Listening for a connection from a host */ + TCP_Connection_SYNSent = 1, /**< Unused */ + TCP_Connection_SYNReceived = 2, /**< SYN received, waiting for ACK */ + TCP_Connection_Established = 3, /**< Connection established in both directions */ + TCP_Connection_FINWait1 = 4, /**< Closing, waiting for ACK */ + TCP_Connection_FINWait2 = 5, /**< Closing, waiting for FIN ACK */ + TCP_Connection_CloseWait = 6, /**< Closing, waiting for ACK */ + TCP_Connection_Closing = 7, /**< Unused */ + TCP_Connection_LastACK = 8, /**< Unused */ + TCP_Connection_TimeWait = 9, /**< Unused */ + TCP_Connection_Closed = 10, /**< Connection closed in both directions */ + }; + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a TCP connection buffer structure, including size, data and direction. */ + typedef struct + { + uint16_t Length; /**< Length of data in the TCP application buffer */ + uint8_t Data[TCP_WINDOW_SIZE]; /**< TCP application data buffer */ + bool Direction; /**< Buffer transmission direction, either TCP_PACKETDIR_IN or TCP_PACKETDIR_OUT */ + bool Ready; /**< If data from host, indicates buffer ready to be read, otherwise indicates + * buffer ready to be sent to the host + */ + bool InUse; /**< Indicates if the buffer is locked to to the current direction, and cannot be changed */ + } TCP_ConnectionBuffer_t; + + /** Type define for a TCP connection information structure. */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t SequenceNumberIn; /**< Current TCP sequence number for host-to-device */ + uint32_t SequenceNumberOut; /**< Current TCP sequence number for device-to-host */ + TCP_ConnectionBuffer_t Buffer; /**< Connection application data buffer */ + } TCP_ConnectionInfo_t; + + /** Type define for a complete TCP connection state. */ + typedef struct + { + uint16_t Port; /**< Connection port number on the device */ + uint16_t RemotePort; /**< Connection port number on the host */ + IP_Address_t RemoteAddress; /**< Connection protocol IP address of the host */ + TCP_ConnectionInfo_t Info; /**< Connection information, including application buffer */ + uint8_t State; /**< Current connection state, a value from the \ref TCP_ConnectionStates_t enum */ + } TCP_ConnectionState_t; + + /** Type define for a TCP port state. */ + typedef struct + { + uint16_t Port; /**< TCP port number on the device */ + uint8_t State; /**< Current port state, a value from the \ref TCP_PortStates_t enum */ + void (*ApplicationHandler) (TCP_ConnectionState_t* ConnectionState, + TCP_ConnectionBuffer_t* Buffer); /**< Port application handler */ + } TCP_PortState_t; + + /** Type define for a TCP packet header. */ + typedef struct + { + uint16_t SourcePort; /**< Source port of the TCP packet */ + uint16_t DestinationPort; /**< Destination port of the TCP packet */ + + uint32_t SequenceNumber; /**< Data sequence number of the packet */ + uint32_t AcknowledgmentNumber; /**< Data acknowledgment number of the packet */ + + unsigned Reserved : 4; /**< Reserved, must be all 0 */ + unsigned DataOffset : 4; /**< Offset of the data from the start of the header, in 4 byte chunks */ + uint8_t Flags; /**< TCP packet flags */ + uint16_t WindowSize; /**< Current data window size (bytes remaining in reception buffer) */ + + uint16_t Checksum; /**< TCP checksum */ + uint16_t UrgentPointer; /**< Urgent data pointer */ + } TCP_Header_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void TCP_TCPTask(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + Ethernet_Frame_Info_t* const FrameOUT); + void TCP_Init(void); + bool TCP_SetPortState(const uint16_t Port, + const uint8_t State, + void (*Handler)(TCP_ConnectionState_t*, TCP_ConnectionBuffer_t*)); + uint8_t TCP_GetPortState(const uint16_t Port); + bool TCP_SetConnectionState(const uint16_t Port, + const IP_Address_t* RemoteAddress, + const uint16_t RemotePort, + const uint8_t State); + uint8_t TCP_GetConnectionState(const uint16_t Port, + const IP_Address_t* RemoteAddress, + const uint16_t RemotePort); + TCP_ConnectionInfo_t* TCP_GetConnectionInfo(const uint16_t Port, + const IP_Address_t* RemoteAddress, + const uint16_t RemotePort); + int16_t TCP_ProcessTCPPacket(void* IPHeaderInStart, + void* TCPHeaderInStart, + void* TCPHeaderOutStart); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_TCP_C) + static uint16_t TCP_Checksum16(void* TCPHeaderOutStart, + const IP_Address_t* SourceAddress, + const IP_Address_t* DestinationAddress, + uint16_t TCPOutSize); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/UDP.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/UDP.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..03c19e00ed --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/UDP.c @@ -0,0 +1,84 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * User Datagram Protocol (UDP) packet handling routines. This protocol handles high throughput, low + * reliability packets which are typically used to encapsulate streaming data. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_UDP_C +#include "UDP.h" + +/** Processes a UDP packet inside an Ethernet frame, and writes the appropriate response + * to the output Ethernet frame if a sub-protocol handler has created a response packet. + * + * \param[in] IPHeaderInStart Pointer to the start of the incoming packet's IP header + * \param[in] UDPHeaderInStart Pointer to the start of the incoming packet's UDP header + * \param[out] UDPHeaderOutStart Pointer to the start of the outgoing packet's UDP header + * + * \return The number of bytes written to the out Ethernet frame if any, NO_RESPONSE otherwise + */ +int16_t UDP_ProcessUDPPacket(void* IPHeaderInStart, + void* UDPHeaderInStart, + void* UDPHeaderOutStart) +{ + UDP_Header_t* UDPHeaderIN = (UDP_Header_t*)UDPHeaderInStart; + UDP_Header_t* UDPHeaderOUT = (UDP_Header_t*)UDPHeaderOutStart; + + int16_t RetSize = NO_RESPONSE; + + DecodeUDPHeader(UDPHeaderInStart); + + switch (SwapEndian_16(UDPHeaderIN->DestinationPort)) + { + case UDP_PORT_DHCP_REQUEST: + RetSize = DHCP_ProcessDHCPPacket(IPHeaderInStart, + &((uint8_t*)UDPHeaderInStart)[sizeof(UDP_Header_t)], + &((uint8_t*)UDPHeaderOutStart)[sizeof(UDP_Header_t)]); + break; + } + + /* Check to see if the protocol processing routine has filled out a response */ + if (RetSize > 0) + { + /* Fill out the response UDP packet header */ + UDPHeaderOUT->SourcePort = UDPHeaderIN->DestinationPort; + UDPHeaderOUT->DestinationPort = UDPHeaderIN->SourcePort; + UDPHeaderOUT->Checksum = 0; + UDPHeaderOUT->Length = SwapEndian_16(sizeof(UDP_Header_t) + RetSize); + + /* Return the size of the response so far */ + return (sizeof(UDP_Header_t) + RetSize); + } + + return NO_RESPONSE; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/UDP.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/UDP.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..459d8be40f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/UDP.h @@ -0,0 +1,70 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for UDP.c. + */ + +#ifndef _UDP_H_ +#define _UDP_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + + #include "EthernetProtocols.h" + #include "Ethernet.h" + #include "ProtocolDecoders.h" + #include "DHCP.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Source UDP port for a DHCP request. */ + #define UDP_PORT_DHCP_REQUEST 67 + + /** Destination UDP port for a DHCP reply. */ + #define UDP_PORT_DHCP_REPLY 68 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a UDP packet header. */ + typedef struct + { + uint16_t SourcePort; /**< Packet source port */ + uint16_t DestinationPort; /**< Packet destination port */ + uint16_t Length; /**< Total packet length, in bytes */ + uint16_t Checksum; /**< Optional UDP packet checksum */ + } UDP_Header_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + int16_t UDP_ProcessUDPPacket(void* IPHeaderInStart, + void* UDPHeaderInStart, + void* UDPHeaderOutStart); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Webserver.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Webserver.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..be4c3a6f6b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Webserver.c @@ -0,0 +1,203 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Simple webserver application for demonstrating the RNDIS demo and TCP/IP stack. This + * application will serve up a static HTTP web page when requested by the host. + */ + +#include "Webserver.h" + +/** HTTP server response header, for transmission before the page contents. This indicates to the host that a page exists at the + * given location, and gives extra connection information. + */ +const char HTTP200Header[] PROGMEM = "HTTP/1.1 200 OK\r\n" + "Server: LUFA RNDIS\r\n" + "Content-type: text/html\r\n" + "Connection: close\r\n\r\n"; + +/** HTTP server response header, for transmission before a resource not found error. This indicates to the host that the given + * given URL is invalid, and gives extra error information. + */ +const char HTTP404Header[] PROGMEM = "HTTP/1.1 404 Not Found\r\n" + "Server: LUFA RNDIS\r\n" + "Connection: close\r\n\r\n"; + +/** HTTP page to serve to the host when a HTTP request is made. This page is too long for a single response, thus it is automatically + * broken up into smaller blocks and sent as a series of packets each time the webserver application callback is run. + */ +const char HTTPPage[] PROGMEM = + "<html>" + " <head>" + " <title>" + " LUFA Webserver Demo" + " </title>" + " </head>" + " <body>" + " <h1>Hello from your USB AVR!</h1>" + " <p>" + " Hello! Welcome to the LUFA RNDIS Demo Webserver test page, running on your USB AVR via the LUFA library. This demonstrates the HTTP webserver, TCP/IP stack and RNDIS demo all running atop the LUFA USB stack." + " <br /><br />" + " <small>Project Information: <a href=\"http://www.lufa-lib.org\">http://www.lufa-lib.org</a>.</small>" + " <hr />" + " <i>LUFA Version: </i>" LUFA_VERSION_STRING + " </p>" + " </body>" + "</html>"; + + +/** Initializes the Webserver application, opening the appropriate HTTP port in the TCP handler and registering the application + * callback routine for packets sent to the HTTP protocol port. + */ +void Webserver_Init(void) +{ + /* Open the HTTP port in the TCP protocol so that HTTP connections to the device can be established */ + TCP_SetPortState(TCP_PORT_HTTP, TCP_Port_Open, Webserver_ApplicationCallback); +} + +/** Indicates if a given request equals the given HTTP command. + * + * \param[in] RequestHeader HTTP request made by the host + * \param[in] Command HTTP command to compare the request to + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command matches the request, \c false otherwise + */ +static bool IsHTTPCommand(uint8_t* RequestHeader, + char* Command) +{ + /* Returns true if the non null terminated string in RequestHeader matches the null terminated string Command */ + return (strncmp((char*)RequestHeader, Command, strlen(Command)) == 0); +} + +/** Application callback routine, executed each time the TCP processing task runs. This callback determines what request + * has been made (if any), and serves up appropriate responses. + * + * \param[in] ConnectionState Pointer to a TCP Connection State structure giving connection information + * \param[in,out] Buffer Pointer to the application's send/receive packet buffer + */ +void Webserver_ApplicationCallback(TCP_ConnectionState_t* const ConnectionState, + TCP_ConnectionBuffer_t* const Buffer) +{ + char* BufferDataStr = (char*)Buffer->Data; + static uint8_t PageBlock = 0; + + /* Check to see if a packet has been received on the HTTP port from a remote host */ + if (TCP_APP_HAS_RECEIVED_PACKET(Buffer)) + { + if (IsHTTPCommand(Buffer->Data, "GET")) + { + if (IsHTTPCommand(Buffer->Data, "GET / ")) + { + PageBlock = 0; + + /* Copy the HTTP 200 response header into the packet buffer */ + strcpy_P(BufferDataStr, HTTP200Header); + + /* Send the buffer contents to the host */ + TCP_APP_SEND_BUFFER(Buffer, strlen(BufferDataStr)); + + /* Lock the buffer to Device->Host transmissions only while we send the page contents */ + TCP_APP_CAPTURE_BUFFER(Buffer); + } + else + { + /* Copy the HTTP 404 response header into the packet buffer */ + strcpy_P(BufferDataStr, HTTP404Header); + + /* Send the buffer contents to the host */ + TCP_APP_SEND_BUFFER(Buffer, strlen(BufferDataStr)); + + /* All data sent, close the connection */ + TCP_APP_CLOSECONNECTION(ConnectionState); + } + } + else if (IsHTTPCommand(Buffer->Data, "HEAD")) + { + if (IsHTTPCommand(Buffer->Data, "HEAD / ")) + { + /* Copy the HTTP response header into the packet buffer */ + strcpy_P(BufferDataStr, HTTP200Header); + + /* Send the buffer contents to the host */ + TCP_APP_SEND_BUFFER(Buffer, strlen(BufferDataStr)); + } + else + { + /* Copy the HTTP response header into the packet buffer */ + strcpy_P(BufferDataStr, HTTP404Header); + + /* Send the buffer contents to the host */ + TCP_APP_SEND_BUFFER(Buffer, strlen(BufferDataStr)); + } + + /* All data sent, close the connection */ + TCP_APP_CLOSECONNECTION(ConnectionState); + } + else if (IsHTTPCommand(Buffer->Data, "TRACE")) + { + /* Echo the host's query back to the host */ + TCP_APP_SEND_BUFFER(Buffer, Buffer->Length); + + /* All data sent, close the connection */ + TCP_APP_CLOSECONNECTION(ConnectionState); + } + else + { + /* Unknown request, just clear the buffer (drop the packet) */ + TCP_APP_CLEAR_BUFFER(Buffer); + } + } + else if (TCP_APP_HAVE_CAPTURED_BUFFER(Buffer)) + { + uint16_t RemLength = strlen_P(&HTTPPage[PageBlock * HTTP_REPLY_BLOCK_SIZE]); + uint16_t Length; + + /* Determine the length of the loaded block */ + Length = ((RemLength > HTTP_REPLY_BLOCK_SIZE) ? HTTP_REPLY_BLOCK_SIZE : RemLength); + + /* Copy the next buffer sized block of the page to the packet buffer */ + strncpy_P(BufferDataStr, &HTTPPage[PageBlock * HTTP_REPLY_BLOCK_SIZE], Length); + + /* Send the buffer contents to the host */ + TCP_APP_SEND_BUFFER(Buffer, Length); + + /* Check to see if the entire page has been sent */ + if (PageBlock++ == (sizeof(HTTPPage) / HTTP_REPLY_BLOCK_SIZE)) + { + /* Unlock the buffer so that the host can fill it with future packets */ + TCP_APP_RELEASE_BUFFER(Buffer); + + /* Close the connection to the host */ + TCP_APP_CLOSECONNECTION(ConnectionState); + } + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Webserver.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Webserver.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e8bb542c14 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Webserver.h @@ -0,0 +1,57 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Webserver.c. + */ + +#ifndef _WEBSERVER_H_ +#define _WEBSERVER_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Version.h> + + #include "TCP.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Maximum size of a HTTP response per transmission */ + #define HTTP_REPLY_BLOCK_SIZE 128 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void Webserver_Init(void); + void Webserver_ApplicationCallback(TCP_ConnectionState_t* const ConnectionState, + TCP_ConnectionBuffer_t* const Buffer); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..aac1b146d6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.c @@ -0,0 +1,179 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the RNDISEthernet demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "RNDISEthernet.h" + +/** Message buffer for RNDIS messages processed by the RNDIS device class driver. */ +static uint8_t RNDIS_Message_Buffer[192]; + +/** Global to store the incoming frame from the host before it is processed by the device. */ +static Ethernet_Frame_Info_t FrameIN; + +/** Global to store the outgoing frame created in the device before it is sent to the host. */ +static Ethernet_Frame_Info_t FrameOUT; + +/** LUFA RNDIS Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all RNDIS Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .ControlInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .AdapterVendorDescription = "LUFA RNDIS Demo Adapter", + .AdapterMACAddress = {ADAPTER_MAC_ADDRESS}, + .MessageBuffer = RNDIS_Message_Buffer, + .MessageBufferLength = sizeof(RNDIS_Message_Buffer), + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + TCP_Init(); + Webserver_Init(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + if (RNDIS_Device_IsPacketReceived(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface)) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + + RNDIS_Device_ReadPacket(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface, &FrameIN.FrameData, &FrameIN.FrameLength); + Ethernet_ProcessPacket(&FrameIN, &FrameOUT); + + if (FrameOUT.FrameLength) + { + RNDIS_Device_SendPacket(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface, &FrameOUT.FrameData, FrameOUT.FrameLength); + FrameOUT.FrameLength = 0; + } + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + } + + TCP_TCPTask(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface, &FrameOUT); + + RNDIS_Device_USBTask(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + Serial_Init(9600, false); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= RNDIS_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + RNDIS_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ab2488b77e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.h @@ -0,0 +1,84 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for RNDISEthernet.c. + */ + +#ifndef _RNDISETHERNET_H_ +#define _RNDISETHERNET_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include "Lib/Ethernet.h" + #include "Lib/TCP.h" + #include "Lib/ARP.h" + #include "Lib/Webserver.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a2c2ac604b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.txt @@ -0,0 +1,146 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage RNDIS Class Ethernet Demo (with Webserver/Telnet) + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Remote NDIS (Microsoft Proprietary CDC Class Networking Standard)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>Microsoft RNDIS Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Remote Network Driver Interface demonstration application. + * This gives a simple reference application for implementing + * a CDC RNDIS device acting as a simple network interface for + * ethernet packet exchange. RNDIS is a proprietary Microsoft + * standard; this demo will only work on Windows 2000 (manually + * patched with the Microsoft RNDIS hotfix) and above (with no + * manual patches), or on the latest Linux kernels. + * + * Before running, you will need to install the INF file that + * is located in the RNDISEthernet project directory. This will + * enable Windows to use its inbuilt RNDIS drivers, negating the + * need for special Windows drivers for the device. To install, + * right-click the .INF file and choose the Install option. If + * Windows 2000 is used, the Microsoft INF file in the hotfix + * will need to be altered to use the VID/PID of the demo and + * then chosen instead of the LUFA RNDIS INF file when prompted. + * + * When enumerated, this demo will install as a new network + * adapter which ethernet packets can be sent to and received + * from. Running on top of the adapter is a very simple TCP/IP + * stack with a HTTP webserver and TELNET host which can be + * accessed through a web browser at IP address 10.0.0.2:80 or + * through a TELNET client at 10.0.0.2:25. This device also supports + * ping echos via the ICMP protocol. + * + * \note The TCP/IP stack in this demo has a number of limitations + * and should serve as an example only - it is not fully featured nor + * compliant to the TCP/IP specification. For complete projects, it is + * recommended that it be replaced with an external open source TCP/IP + * stack that is feature complete, such as the uIP stack. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>CLIENT_IP_ADDRESS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Configures the IP address given to the client (PC) via the DHCP server.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>SERVER_IP_ADDRESS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Configures the IP address of the virtual server.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ADAPTER_MAC_ADDRESS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Configures the MAC address of the RNDIS adapter on the host (PC) side.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Configures the MAC address of the virtual server on the network.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_DECODE_ETHERNET</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, received Ethernet headers will not be decoded and printed to the device serial port.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_DECODE_ARP</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, received ARP headers will not be decoded and printed to the device serial port.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_DECODE_IP</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, received IP headers will not be decoded and printed to the device serial port.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_DECODE_ICMP</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, received ICMP headers will not be decoded and printed to the device serial port.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_DECODE_TCP</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, received TCP headers will not be decoded and printed to the device serial port.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_DECODE_UDP</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, received UDP headers will not be decoded and printed to the device serial port.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_DECODE_DHCP</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, received DHCP headers will not be decoded and printed to the device serial port.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e871a8799e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,84 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="RNDIS Ethernet Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.rndis.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.rndis"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="RNDIS Ethernet Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.rndis.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.rndis"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.class.rndis" caption="RNDIS Ethernet Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Microsoft RNDIS Ethernet networking device demo, implementing a basic HTTP webserver. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="RNDIS Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="RNDISEthernet.txt"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="LUFA RNDIS.inf"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="RNDISEthernet.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/ARP.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/DHCP.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/Ethernet.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/ICMP.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/IP.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/ProtocolDecoders.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/TCP.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/UDP.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/Webserver.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="RNDISEthernet.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/ARP.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/DHCP.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/Ethernet.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/ICMP.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/IP.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/ProtocolDecoders.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/TCP.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/UDP.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/Webserver.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/EthernetProtocols.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..29d07c317f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - RNDIS Ethernet Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c6a3a54a44 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernet/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,44 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = RNDISEthernet +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c Lib/Ethernet.c Lib/ProtocolDecoders.c Lib/ICMP.c Lib/TCP.c Lib/UDP.c Lib/DHCP.c Lib/ARP.c \ + Lib/IP.c Lib/Webserver.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0ec4635eb0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 4 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5ec042cb04 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,245 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2044, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .CDC_CCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Header = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .CDCSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + }, + + .CDC_Functional_ACM = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ACM, + + .Capabilities = 0x06, + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Union = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Union, + + .MasterInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .SlaveInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + }, + + .CDC_NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0xFF + }, + + .CDC_DCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .CDC_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA CDC Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5b4bf2aa7b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,110 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 2) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_TX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define CDC_RX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE 8 + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC data IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE 16 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // CDC Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_CCI_Interface; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t CDC_Functional_Header; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t CDC_Functional_ACM; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t CDC_Functional_Union; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_NotificationEndpoint; + + // CDC Data Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_DCI_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataOutEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataInEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI = 0, /**< CDC CCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI = 1, /**< CDC DCI interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/LUFA VirtualSerial.inf b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/LUFA VirtualSerial.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..21d2d12b6e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/LUFA VirtualSerial.inf @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +;************************************************************ +; Windows USB CDC ACM Setup File +; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation +;************************************************************ + +[DefaultInstall] +CopyINF="LUFA VirtualSerial.inf" + +[Version] +Signature="$Windows NT$" +Class=Ports +ClassGuid={4D36E978-E325-11CE-BFC1-08002BE10318} +Provider=%MFGNAME% +DriverVer=7/1/2012,10.0.0.0 + +[Manufacturer] +%MFGNAME%=DeviceList, NTx86, NTamd64, NTia64 + +[SourceDisksNames] + +[SourceDisksFiles] + +[DestinationDirs] +DefaultDestDir=12 + +[DriverInstall] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +CopyFiles=FakeModemCopyFileSection +AddReg=DriverInstall.AddReg + +[DriverInstall.Services] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +AddService=usbser, 0x00000002, LowerFilter_Service_Inst + +[DriverInstall.AddReg] +HKR,,EnumPropPages32,,"msports.dll,SerialPortPropPageProvider" + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; Vendor and Product ID Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; When developing your USB device, the VID and PID used in the PC side +; application program and the firmware on the microcontroller must match. +; Modify the below line to use your VID and PID. Use the format as shown below. +; Note: One INF file can be used for multiple devices with different VID and PIDs. +; For each supported device, append ",USB\VID_xxxx&PID_yyyy" to the end of the line. +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[DeviceList] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2044 + +[DeviceList.NTx86] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2044 + +[DeviceList.NTamd64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2044 + +[DeviceList.NTia64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2044 + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; String Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +;Modify these strings to customize your device +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[Strings] +MFGNAME="http://www.lufa-lib.org" +DESCRIPTION="LUFA CDC-ACM Virtual Serial Port"
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/VirtualSerial.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/VirtualSerial.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a3d419ae5c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/VirtualSerial.c @@ -0,0 +1,202 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the VirtualSerial demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "VirtualSerial.h" + +/** LUFA CDC Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all CDC Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .ControlInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + }, + }; + +/** Standard file stream for the CDC interface when set up, so that the virtual CDC COM port can be + * used like any regular character stream in the C APIs. + */ +static FILE USBSerialStream; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + /* Create a regular character stream for the interface so that it can be used with the stdio.h functions */ + CDC_Device_CreateStream(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface, &USBSerialStream); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + CheckJoystickMovement(); + + /* Must throw away unused bytes from the host, or it will lock up while waiting for the device */ + CDC_Device_ReceiveByte(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + + CDC_Device_USBTask(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Joystick_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Checks for changes in the position of the board joystick, sending strings to the host upon each change. */ +void CheckJoystickMovement(void) +{ + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + char* ReportString = NULL; + static bool ActionSent = false; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + ReportString = "Joystick Up\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + ReportString = "Joystick Down\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + ReportString = "Joystick Left\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + ReportString = "Joystick Right\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + ReportString = "Joystick Pressed\r\n"; + else + ActionSent = false; + + if ((ReportString != NULL) && (ActionSent == false)) + { + ActionSent = true; + + /* Write the string to the virtual COM port via the created character stream */ + fputs(ReportString, &USBSerialStream); + + /* Alternatively, without the stream: */ + // CDC_Device_SendString(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface, ReportString); + } +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= CDC_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + CDC_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); +} + +/** CDC class driver callback function the processing of changes to the virtual + * control lines sent from the host.. + * + * \param[in] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to the CDC class interface configuration structure being referenced + */ +void EVENT_CDC_Device_ControLineStateChanged(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t *const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + /* You can get changes to the virtual CDC lines in this callback; a common + use-case is to use the Data Terminal Ready (DTR) flag to enable and + disable CDC communications in your application when set to avoid the + application blocking while waiting for a host to become ready and read + in the pending data from the USB endpoints. + */ + bool HostReady = (CDCInterfaceInfo->State.ControlLineStates.HostToDevice & CDC_CONTROL_LINE_OUT_DTR) != 0; +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/VirtualSerial.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/VirtualSerial.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..89f809982b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/VirtualSerial.h @@ -0,0 +1,77 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for VirtualSerial.c. + */ + +#ifndef _VIRTUALSERIAL_H_ +#define _VIRTUALSERIAL_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <string.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void CheckJoystickMovement(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/VirtualSerial.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/VirtualSerial.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c802d99504 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/VirtualSerial.txt @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Communications Device Class (Virtual Serial Port) Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Abstract Control Model (ACM)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF CDC Class Standard</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Communications Device Class demonstration application. + * This gives a simple reference application for implementing + * a CDC device acting as a virtual serial port. Joystick + * actions are transmitted to the host as strings. The device + * does not respond to serial data sent from the host. + * + * After running this demo for the first time on a new computer, + * you will need to supply the .INF file located in this demo + * project's directory as the device's driver when running under + * Windows. This will enable Windows to use its inbuilt CDC drivers, + * negating the need for custom drivers for the device. Other + * Operating Systems should automatically use their own inbuilt + * CDC-ACM drivers. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4839b7c5f8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Virtual Serial CDC Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.cdc.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.cdc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Virtual Serial CDC Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.cdc.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.cdc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.class.cdc" caption="Virtual Serial CDC Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Virtual Serial device demo, implementing a virtual serial channel between the host PC and the device. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="CDC Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="VirtualSerial.txt"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="LUFA VirtualSerial.inf"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="VirtualSerial.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="VirtualSerial.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..aa21df5823 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Virtual Serial Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f0f73257a8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerial/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = VirtualSerial +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b18b2c4149 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define TOTAL_LUNS 1 + + #define DISK_READ_ONLY false + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..62549878d6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 5 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9c8792c336 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,295 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_IADDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_IADDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_IADDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2068, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 3, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .CDC_IAD = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_Association_t), .Type = DTYPE_InterfaceAssociation}, + + .FirstInterfaceIndex = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .IADStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_CCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Header = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .CDCSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + }, + + .CDC_Functional_ACM = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ACM, + + .Capabilities = 0x06, + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Union = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Union, + + .MasterInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .SlaveInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + }, + + .CDC_NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0xFF + }, + + .CDC_DCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .CDC_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .MS_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = MS_CSCP_MassStorageClass, + .SubClass = MS_CSCP_SCSITransparentSubclass, + .Protocol = MS_CSCP_BulkOnlyTransportProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MS_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .MS_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA CDC and Mass Storage Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..43c2b3165c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,128 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_TX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 2) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define CDC_RX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 3) + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE 8 + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC data IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE 16 + + /** Endpoint address of the Mass Storage device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 4) + + /** Endpoint address of the Mass Storage host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 5) + + /** Size in bytes of the Mass Storage data endpoints. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE 64 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // CDC Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_Association_t CDC_IAD; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_CCI_Interface; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t CDC_Functional_Header; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t CDC_Functional_ACM; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t CDC_Functional_Union; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_NotificationEndpoint; + + // CDC Data Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_DCI_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataOutEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataInEndpoint; + + // Mass Storage Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t MS_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t MS_DataInEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t MS_DataOutEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI = 0, /**< CDC CCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI = 1, /**< CDC DCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage = 2, /**< Mass storage interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/LUFA VirtualSerialMassStorage.inf b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/LUFA VirtualSerialMassStorage.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e5d8da5e38 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/LUFA VirtualSerialMassStorage.inf @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +;************************************************************ +; Windows USB CDC ACM Setup File +; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation +;************************************************************ + +[DefaultInstall] +CopyINF="LUFA VirtualSerialMassStorage.inf" + +[Version] +Signature="$Windows NT$" +Class=Ports +ClassGuid={4D36E978-E325-11CE-BFC1-08002BE10318} +Provider=%MFGNAME% +DriverVer=7/1/2012,10.0.0.0 + +[Manufacturer] +%MFGNAME%=DeviceList, NTx86, NTamd64, NTia64 + +[SourceDisksNames] + +[SourceDisksFiles] + +[DestinationDirs] +DefaultDestDir=12 + +[DriverInstall] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +CopyFiles=FakeModemCopyFileSection +AddReg=DriverInstall.AddReg + +[DriverInstall.Services] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +AddService=usbser, 0x00000002, LowerFilter_Service_Inst + +[DriverInstall.AddReg] +HKR,,EnumPropPages32,,"msports.dll,SerialPortPropPageProvider" + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; Vendor and Product ID Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; When developing your USB device, the VID and PID used in the PC side +; application program and the firmware on the microcontroller must match. +; Modify the below line to use your VID and PID. Use the format as shown below. +; Note: One INF file can be used for multiple devices with different VID and PIDs. +; For each supported device, append ",USB\VID_xxxx&PID_yyyy" to the end of the line. +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[DeviceList] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2068&MI_00 + +[DeviceList.NTx86] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2068&MI_00 + +[DeviceList.NTamd64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2068&MI_00 + +[DeviceList.NTia64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2068&MI_00 + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; String Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +;Modify these strings to customize your device +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[Strings] +MFGNAME="http://www.lufa-lib.org" +DESCRIPTION="LUFA CDC-ACM Virtual Serial Port"
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Lib/DataflashManager.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Lib/DataflashManager.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c0fd16ccc4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Lib/DataflashManager.c @@ -0,0 +1,534 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Functions to manage the physical Dataflash media, including reading and writing of + * blocks of data. These functions are called by the SCSI layer when data must be stored + * or retrieved to/from the physical storage media. If a different media is used (such + * as a SD card or EEPROM), functions similar to these will need to be generated. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_DATAFLASHMANAGER_C +#include "DataflashManager.h" + +/** Writes blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) to the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), from + * the pre-selected data OUT endpoint. This routine reads in OS sized blocks from the endpoint and writes + * them to the Dataflash in Dataflash page sized blocks. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Mass Storage Class configuration and state + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the write sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to write + */ +void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + bool UsingSecondBuffer = false; + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, CurrDFPageByte); + + /* Wait until endpoint is ready before continuing */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Write an endpoint packet sized data block to the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if the endpoint is currently empty */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + /* Clear the current endpoint bank */ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + /* Wait until the host has sent another packet */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + } + + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Once all the Dataflash ICs have had their first buffers filled, switch buffers to maintain throughput */ + if (Dataflash_GetSelectedChip() == DATAFLASH_CHIP_MASK(DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS)) + UsingSecondBuffer = !(UsingSecondBuffer); + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* If less than one Dataflash page remaining, copy over the existing page to preserve trailing data */ + if ((TotalBlocks * (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) < (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF2 : DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + } +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2WRITE : DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, 0); + } + + /* Write one 16-byte chunk of data to the Dataflash */ + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + + /* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ + if (MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset) + return; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0x00); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + + /* If the endpoint is empty, clear it ready for the next packet from the host */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Reads blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) from the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), into + * the pre-selected data IN endpoint. This routine reads in Dataflash page sized blocks from the Dataflash + * and writes them in OS sized blocks to the endpoint. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Mass Storage Class configuration and state + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the read sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to read + */ +void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, CurrDFPageByte); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + + /* Wait until endpoint is ready before continuing */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Read an endpoint packet sized data block from the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if the endpoint is currently full */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + /* Clear the endpoint bank to send its contents to the host */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Wait until the endpoint is ready for more data */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + } + + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + } + + /* Read one 16-byte chunk of data from the Dataflash */ + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + + /* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ + if (MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset) + return; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* If the endpoint is full, send its contents to the host */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Writes blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) to the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), from + * the given RAM buffer. This routine reads in OS sized blocks from the buffer and writes them to the + * Dataflash in Dataflash page sized blocks. This can be linked to FAT libraries to write files to the + * Dataflash. + * + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the write sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to write + * \param[in] BufferPtr Pointer to the data source RAM buffer + */ +void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + bool UsingSecondBuffer = false; + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, CurrDFPageByte); + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Write an endpoint packet sized data block to the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Once all the Dataflash ICs have had their first buffers filled, switch buffers to maintain throughput */ + if (Dataflash_GetSelectedChip() == DATAFLASH_CHIP_MASK(DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS)) + UsingSecondBuffer = !(UsingSecondBuffer); + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* If less than one Dataflash page remaining, copy over the existing page to preserve trailing data */ + if ((TotalBlocks * (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) < (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF2 : DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + } +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2WRITE : DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, 0); + } + + /* Write one 16-byte chunk of data to the Dataflash */ + for (uint8_t ByteNum = 0; ByteNum < 16; ByteNum++) + Dataflash_SendByte(*(BufferPtr++)); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0x00); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Reads blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) from the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), into + * the preallocated RAM buffer. This routine reads in Dataflash page sized blocks from the Dataflash + * and writes them in OS sized blocks to the given buffer. This can be linked to FAT libraries to read + * the files stored on the Dataflash. + * + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the read sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to read + * \param[out] BufferPtr Pointer to the data destination RAM buffer + */ +void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, CurrDFPageByte); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Read an endpoint packet sized data block from the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + } + + /* Read one 16-byte chunk of data from the Dataflash */ + for (uint8_t ByteNum = 0; ByteNum < 16; ByteNum++) + *(BufferPtr++) = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Disables the Dataflash memory write protection bits on the board Dataflash ICs, if enabled. */ +void DataflashManager_ResetDataflashProtections(void) +{ + /* Select first Dataflash chip, send the read status register command */ + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + + /* Check if sector protection is enabled */ + if (Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_SECTORPROTECTION_ON) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + + /* Send the commands to disable sector protection */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[0]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[1]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[2]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[3]); + } + + /* Select second Dataflash chip (if present on selected board), send read status register command */ + #if (DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS == 2) + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP2); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + + /* Check if sector protection is enabled */ + if (Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_SECTORPROTECTION_ON) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + + /* Send the commands to disable sector protection */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[0]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[1]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[2]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[3]); + } + #endif + + /* Deselect current Dataflash chip */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Performs a simple test on the attached Dataflash IC(s) to ensure that they are working. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if all media chips are working, \c false otherwise + */ +bool DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation(void) +{ + uint8_t ReturnByte; + + /* Test first Dataflash IC is present and responding to commands */ + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_READMANUFACTURERDEVICEINFO); + ReturnByte = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + /* If returned data is invalid, fail the command */ + if (ReturnByte != DF_MANUFACTURER_ATMEL) + return false; + + #if (DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS == 2) + /* Test second Dataflash IC is present and responding to commands */ + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP2); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_READMANUFACTURERDEVICEINFO); + ReturnByte = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + /* If returned data is invalid, fail the command */ + if (ReturnByte != DF_MANUFACTURER_ATMEL) + return false; + #endif + + return true; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Lib/DataflashManager.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Lib/DataflashManager.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e44e61835e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Lib/DataflashManager.h @@ -0,0 +1,89 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for DataflashManager.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DATAFLASH_MANAGER_H_ +#define _DATAFLASH_MANAGER_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + + #include "../VirtualSerialMassStorage.h" + #include "../Descriptors.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h> + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE % 16) + #error Dataflash page size must be a multiple of 16 bytes. + #endif + + /* Defines: */ + /** Total number of bytes of the storage medium, comprised of one or more Dataflash ICs. */ + #define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES ((uint32_t)DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) + + /** Block size of the device. This is kept at 512 to remain compatible with the OS despite the underlying + * storage media (Dataflash) using a different native block size. Do not change this value. + */ + #define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE 512 + + /** Total number of blocks of the virtual memory for reporting to the host as the device's total capacity. Do not + * change this value; change VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES instead to alter the media size. + */ + #define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCKS (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES / VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + + /** Blocks in each LUN, calculated from the total capacity divided by the total number of Logical Units in the device. */ + #define LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCKS / TOTAL_LUNS) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks); + void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks); + void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + void DataflashManager_ResetDataflashProtections(void); + bool DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Lib/SCSI.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Lib/SCSI.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8780d1603d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Lib/SCSI.c @@ -0,0 +1,349 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * SCSI command processing routines, for SCSI commands issued by the host. Mass Storage + * devices use a thin "Bulk-Only Transport" protocol for issuing commands and status information, + * which wrap around standard SCSI device commands for controlling the actual storage medium. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_SCSI_C +#include "SCSI.h" + +/** Structure to hold the SCSI response data to a SCSI INQUIRY command. This gives information about the device's + * features and capabilities. + */ +static const SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t InquiryData = + { + .DeviceType = DEVICE_TYPE_BLOCK, + .PeripheralQualifier = 0, + + .Removable = true, + + .Version = 0, + + .ResponseDataFormat = 2, + .NormACA = false, + .TrmTsk = false, + .AERC = false, + + .AdditionalLength = 0x1F, + + .SoftReset = false, + .CmdQue = false, + .Linked = false, + .Sync = false, + .WideBus16Bit = false, + .WideBus32Bit = false, + .RelAddr = false, + + .VendorID = "LUFA", + .ProductID = "Dataflash Disk", + .RevisionID = {'0','.','0','0'}, + }; + +/** Structure to hold the sense data for the last issued SCSI command, which is returned to the host after a SCSI REQUEST SENSE + * command is issued. This gives information on exactly why the last command failed to complete. + */ +static SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t SenseData = + { + .ResponseCode = 0x70, + .AdditionalLength = 0x0A, + }; + + +/** Main routine to process the SCSI command located in the Command Block Wrapper read from the host. This dispatches + * to the appropriate SCSI command handling routine if the issued command is supported by the device, else it returns + * a command failure due to a ILLEGAL REQUEST. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise + */ +bool SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + bool CommandSuccess = false; + + /* Run the appropriate SCSI command hander function based on the passed command */ + switch (MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[0]) + { + case SCSI_CMD_INQUIRY: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Inquiry(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_REQUEST_SENSE: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_READ_CAPACITY_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_SEND_DIAGNOSTIC: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_WRITE_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(MSInterfaceInfo, DATA_WRITE); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_READ_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(MSInterfaceInfo, DATA_READ); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_MODE_SENSE_6: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_START_STOP_UNIT: + case SCSI_CMD_TEST_UNIT_READY: + case SCSI_CMD_PREVENT_ALLOW_MEDIUM_REMOVAL: + case SCSI_CMD_VERIFY_10: + /* These commands should just succeed, no handling required */ + CommandSuccess = true; + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength = 0; + break; + default: + /* Update the SENSE key to reflect the invalid command */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_COMMAND, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + break; + } + + /* Check if command was successfully processed */ + if (CommandSuccess) + { + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_GOOD, + SCSI_ASENSE_NO_ADDITIONAL_INFORMATION, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return true; + } + + return false; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI INQUIRY command. This command returns information about the device's features + * and capabilities to the host. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Inquiry(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint16_t AllocationLength = SwapEndian_16(*(uint16_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[3]); + uint16_t BytesTransferred = MIN(AllocationLength, sizeof(InquiryData)); + + /* Only the standard INQUIRY data is supported, check if any optional INQUIRY bits set */ + if ((MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[1] & ((1 << 0) | (1 << 1))) || + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[2]) + { + /* Optional but unsupported bits set - update the SENSE key and fail the request */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_FIELD_IN_CDB, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&InquiryData, BytesTransferred, NULL); + + /* Pad out remaining bytes with 0x00 */ + Endpoint_Null_Stream((AllocationLength - BytesTransferred), NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= BytesTransferred; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI REQUEST SENSE command. This command returns information about the last issued command, + * including the error code and additional error information so that the host can determine why a command failed to complete. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint8_t AllocationLength = MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[4]; + uint8_t BytesTransferred = MIN(AllocationLength, sizeof(SenseData)); + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&SenseData, BytesTransferred, NULL); + Endpoint_Null_Stream((AllocationLength - BytesTransferred), NULL); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= BytesTransferred; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI READ CAPACITY (10) command. This command returns information about the device's capacity + * on the selected Logical Unit (drive), as a number of OS-sized blocks. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint32_t LastBlockAddressInLUN = (LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS - 1); + uint32_t MediaBlockSize = VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE; + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE(&LastBlockAddressInLUN, sizeof(LastBlockAddressInLUN), NULL); + Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE(&MediaBlockSize, sizeof(MediaBlockSize), NULL); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= 8; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI SEND DIAGNOSTIC command. This command performs a quick check of the Dataflash ICs on the + * board, and indicates if they are present and functioning correctly. Only the Self-Test portion of the diagnostic command is + * supported. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + /* Check to see if the SELF TEST bit is not set */ + if (!(MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[1] & (1 << 2))) + { + /* Only self-test supported - update SENSE key and fail the command */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_FIELD_IN_CDB, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Check to see if all attached Dataflash ICs are functional */ + if (!(DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation())) + { + /* Update SENSE key with a hardware error condition and return command fail */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_HARDWARE_ERROR, + SCSI_ASENSE_NO_ADDITIONAL_INFORMATION, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength = 0; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI READ (10) or WRITE (10) command. This command reads in the block start address + * and total number of blocks to process, then calls the appropriate low-level Dataflash routine to handle the actual + * reading and writing of the data. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * \param[in] IsDataRead Indicates if the command is a READ (10) command or WRITE (10) command (DATA_READ or DATA_WRITE) + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const bool IsDataRead) +{ + uint32_t BlockAddress; + uint16_t TotalBlocks; + + /* Check if the disk is write protected or not */ + if ((IsDataRead == DATA_WRITE) && DISK_READ_ONLY) + { + /* Block address is invalid, update SENSE key and return command fail */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_DATA_PROTECT, + SCSI_ASENSE_WRITE_PROTECTED, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Load in the 32-bit block address (SCSI uses big-endian, so have to reverse the byte order) */ + BlockAddress = SwapEndian_32(*(uint32_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[2]); + + /* Load in the 16-bit total blocks (SCSI uses big-endian, so have to reverse the byte order) */ + TotalBlocks = SwapEndian_16(*(uint16_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[7]); + + /* Check if the block address is outside the maximum allowable value for the LUN */ + if (BlockAddress >= LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS) + { + /* Block address is invalid, update SENSE key and return command fail */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_LOGICAL_BLOCK_ADDRESS_OUT_OF_RANGE, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + #if (TOTAL_LUNS > 1) + /* Adjust the given block address to the real media address based on the selected LUN */ + BlockAddress += ((uint32_t)MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.LUN * LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS); + #endif + + /* Determine if the packet is a READ (10) or WRITE (10) command, call appropriate function */ + if (IsDataRead == DATA_READ) + DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(MSInterfaceInfo, BlockAddress, TotalBlocks); + else + DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(MSInterfaceInfo, BlockAddress, TotalBlocks); + + /* Update the bytes transferred counter and succeed the command */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= ((uint32_t)TotalBlocks * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE); + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI MODE SENSE (6) command. This command returns various informational pages about + * the SCSI device, as well as the device's Write Protect status. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + /* Send an empty header response with the Write Protect flag status */ + Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); + Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); + Endpoint_Write_8(DISK_READ_ONLY ? 0x80 : 0x00); + Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Update the bytes transferred counter and succeed the command */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= 4; + + return true; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Lib/SCSI.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Lib/SCSI.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e16c2d46d8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/Lib/SCSI.h @@ -0,0 +1,89 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for SCSI.c. + */ + +#ifndef _SCSI_H_ +#define _SCSI_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "../VirtualSerialMassStorage.h" + #include "../Descriptors.h" + #include "DataflashManager.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Macro to set the current SCSI sense data to the given key, additional sense code and additional sense qualifier. This + * is for convenience, as it allows for all three sense values (returned upon request to the host to give information about + * the last command failure) in a quick and easy manner. + * + * \param[in] Key New SCSI sense key to set the sense code to + * \param[in] Acode New SCSI additional sense key to set the additional sense code to + * \param[in] Aqual New SCSI additional sense key qualifier to set the additional sense qualifier code to + */ + #define SCSI_SET_SENSE(Key, Acode, Aqual) do { SenseData.SenseKey = (Key); \ + SenseData.AdditionalSenseCode = (Acode); \ + SenseData.AdditionalSenseQualifier = (Aqual); } while (0) + + /** Macro for the \ref SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10() function, to indicate that data is to be read from the storage medium. */ + #define DATA_READ true + + /** Macro for the \ref SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10() function, to indicate that data is to be written to the storage medium. */ + #define DATA_WRITE false + + /** Value for the DeviceType entry in the SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t enum, indicating a Block Media device. */ + #define DEVICE_TYPE_BLOCK 0x00 + + /** Value for the DeviceType entry in the SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t enum, indicating a CD-ROM device. */ + #define DEVICE_TYPE_CDROM 0x05 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + bool SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_SCSI_C) + static bool SCSI_Command_Inquiry(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const bool IsDataRead); + static bool SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/VirtualSerialMassStorage.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/VirtualSerialMassStorage.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f298e39cb8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/VirtualSerialMassStorage.c @@ -0,0 +1,257 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the VirtualSerialMassStorage demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "VirtualSerialMassStorage.h" + +/** LUFA CDC Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all CDC Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .ControlInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + }, + }; + +/** LUFA Mass Storage Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all Mass Storage Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t Disk_MS_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR, + .Size = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR, + .Size = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .TotalLUNs = TOTAL_LUNS, + }, + }; + +/** Standard file stream for the CDC interface when set up, so that the virtual CDC COM port can be + * used like any regular character stream in the C APIs. + */ +static FILE USBSerialStream; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + /* Create a regular character stream for the interface so that it can be used with the stdio.h functions */ + CDC_Device_CreateStream(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface, &USBSerialStream); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + CheckJoystickMovement(); + + /* Must throw away unused bytes from the host, or it will lock up while waiting for the device */ + CDC_Device_ReceiveByte(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + + CDC_Device_USBTask(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + MS_Device_USBTask(&Disk_MS_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + Joystick_Init(); + Dataflash_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Check if the Dataflash is working, abort if not */ + if (!(DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation())) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); + } + + /* Clear Dataflash sector protections, if enabled */ + DataflashManager_ResetDataflashProtections(); +} + +/** Checks for changes in the position of the board joystick, sending strings to the host upon each change. */ +void CheckJoystickMovement(void) +{ + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + char* ReportString = NULL; + static bool ActionSent = false; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + ReportString = "Joystick Up\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + ReportString = "Joystick Down\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + ReportString = "Joystick Left\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + ReportString = "Joystick Right\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + ReportString = "Joystick Pressed\r\n"; + else + ActionSent = false; + + if ((ReportString != NULL) && (ActionSent == false)) + { + ActionSent = true; + + /* Write the string to the virtual COM port via the created character stream */ + fputs(ReportString, &USBSerialStream); + + /* Alternatively, without the stream: */ + // CDC_Device_SendString(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface, ReportString); + } +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= CDC_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + ConfigSuccess &= MS_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Disk_MS_Interface); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + CDC_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + MS_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Disk_MS_Interface); +} + +/** CDC class driver callback function the processing of changes to the virtual + * control lines sent from the host.. + * + * \param[in] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to the CDC class interface configuration structure being referenced + */ +void EVENT_CDC_Device_ControLineStateChanged(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t *const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + /* You can get changes to the virtual CDC lines in this callback; a common + use-case is to use the Data Terminal Ready (DTR) flag to enable and + disable CDC communications in your application when set to avoid the + application blocking while waiting for a host to become ready and read + in the pending data from the USB endpoints. + */ + bool HostReady = (CDCInterfaceInfo->State.ControlLineStates.HostToDevice & CDC_CONTROL_LINE_OUT_DTR) != 0; +} + +/** Mass Storage class driver callback function the reception of SCSI commands from the host, which must be processed. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface configuration structure being referenced + */ +bool CALLBACK_MS_Device_SCSICommandReceived(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + bool CommandSuccess; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + CommandSuccess = SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(MSInterfaceInfo); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + + return CommandSuccess; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/VirtualSerialMassStorage.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/VirtualSerialMassStorage.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6df452db35 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/VirtualSerialMassStorage.h @@ -0,0 +1,83 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for VirtualSerial.c. + */ + +#ifndef _VIRTUALSERIAL_H_ +#define _VIRTUALSERIAL_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include "Lib/SCSI.h" + #include "Lib/DataflashManager.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void CheckJoystickMovement(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/VirtualSerialMassStorage.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/VirtualSerialMassStorage.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..246775c221 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/VirtualSerialMassStorage.txt @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Communications Device Class (Virtual Serial Port) and Mass Storage Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC) \n + * Mass Storage Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Abstract Control Model (ACM) \n + * Bulk-Only Transport</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF CDC Class Standard \n + * USBIF Mass Storage Standard \n + * USB Bulk-Only Transport Standard \n + * SCSI Primary Commands Specification \n + * SCSI Block Commands Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Combined Communications Device Class/Mass Storage demonstration application. + * This gives a simple reference application for implementing a combined + * CDC and Mass Storage device acting as a both a virtual serial port and a flash + * drive. Joystick actions are transmitted to the host as strings, and data can be + * written to or read from the exposed flash drive interface in the same manner as + * other USB flash drives. The device does not respond to serial data sent from the + * host. + * + * After running this demo for the first time on a new computer, + * you will need to supply the .INF file located in this demo + * project's directory as the device's driver when running under + * Windows. This will enable Windows to use its inbuilt CDC drivers, + * negating the need for custom drivers for the device. Other + * Operating Systems should automatically use their own inbuilt + * CDC-ACM drivers. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>TOTAL_LUNS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Total number of Logical Units (drives) in the device. The total device capacity is shared equally between each drive - + * this can be set to any positive non-zero amount.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>DISK_READ_ONLY</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Configuration define, indicating if the disk should be write protected or not.</td> + * </tr> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a73bcc21c6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,70 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Virtual Serial CDC and Mass Storage Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.cdc_ms.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.cdc_ms"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Virtual Serial CDC and Mass Storage Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.cdc_ms.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.cdc_ms"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.class.cdc_ms" caption="Virtual Serial CDC and Mass Storage Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Virtual Serial and Mass Storage device demo, implementing a virtual serial channel between the host PC and the device, and a basic USB storage disk using a Dataflash memory IC. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="CDC Class"/>
+ <keyword value="Mass Storage Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="VirtualSerialMassStorage.txt"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="LUFA VirtualSerialMassStorage.inf"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="VirtualSerialMassStorage.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/DataflashManager.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/SCSI.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="VirtualSerialMassStorage.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/DataflashManager.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/SCSI.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.dataflash"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ff418b91dd --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Virtual Serial/Mass Storage Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e40ee286f6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMassStorage/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = VirtualSerialMassStorage +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c Lib/DataflashManager.c Lib/SCSI.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0ec4635eb0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 4 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b4133d8b8a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,323 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + + +/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the + * USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This + * descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding) + * the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for + * more details on HID report descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t PROGMEM MouseReport[] = +{ + /* Use the HID class driver's standard Mouse report. + * Min X/Y Axis values: -1 + * Max X/Y Axis values: 1 + * Min physical X/Y Axis values (used to determine resolution): -1 + * Max physical X/Y Axis values (used to determine resolution): 1 + * Buttons: 3 + * Absolute screen coordinates: false + */ + HID_DESCRIPTOR_MOUSE(-1, 1, -1, 1, 3, false) +}; + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_IADDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_IADDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_IADDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2062, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 3, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .CDC_IAD = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_Association_t), .Type = DTYPE_InterfaceAssociation}, + + .FirstInterfaceIndex = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .IADStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_CCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Header = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .CDCSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + }, + + .CDC_Functional_ACM = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ACM, + + .Capabilities = 0x06, + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Union = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Union, + + .MasterInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .SlaveInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + }, + + .CDC_NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0xFF + }, + + .CDC_DCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .CDC_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .HID_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Mouse, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_BootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_MouseBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID_MouseHID = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(MouseReport) + }, + + .HID_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MOUSE_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MOUSE_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA CDC and Mouse Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + case HID_DTYPE_HID: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID_MouseHID; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + break; + case HID_DTYPE_Report: + Address = &MouseReport; + Size = sizeof(MouseReport); + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..85c1e2c963 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,123 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 2) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_TX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define CDC_RX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE 8 + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC data IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE 16 + + /** Endpoint address of the Mouse HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define MOUSE_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Size in bytes of the Mouse HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define MOUSE_EPSIZE 8 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // CDC Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_Association_t CDC_IAD; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_CCI_Interface; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t CDC_Functional_Header; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t CDC_Functional_ACM; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t CDC_Functional_Union; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_NotificationEndpoint; + + // CDC Data Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_DCI_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataOutEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataInEndpoint; + + // Mouse HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID_Interface; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID_MouseHID; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID_ReportINEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI = 0, /**< CDC CCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI = 1, /**< CDC DCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_Mouse = 2, /**< Mouse interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/LUFA VirtualSerialMouse.inf b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/LUFA VirtualSerialMouse.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ac47e066b5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/LUFA VirtualSerialMouse.inf @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +;************************************************************ +; Windows USB CDC ACM Setup File +; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation +;************************************************************ + +[DefaultInstall] +CopyINF="LUFA VirtualSerialMouse.inf" + +[Version] +Signature="$Windows NT$" +Class=Ports +ClassGuid={4D36E978-E325-11CE-BFC1-08002BE10318} +Provider=%MFGNAME% +DriverVer=7/1/2012,10.0.0.0 + +[Manufacturer] +%MFGNAME%=DeviceList, NTx86, NTamd64, NTia64 + +[SourceDisksNames] + +[SourceDisksFiles] + +[DestinationDirs] +DefaultDestDir=12 + +[DriverInstall] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +CopyFiles=FakeModemCopyFileSection +AddReg=DriverInstall.AddReg + +[DriverInstall.Services] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +AddService=usbser, 0x00000002, LowerFilter_Service_Inst + +[DriverInstall.AddReg] +HKR,,EnumPropPages32,,"msports.dll,SerialPortPropPageProvider" + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; Vendor and Product ID Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; When developing your USB device, the VID and PID used in the PC side +; application program and the firmware on the microcontroller must match. +; Modify the below line to use your VID and PID. Use the format as shown below. +; Note: One INF file can be used for multiple devices with different VID and PIDs. +; For each supported device, append ",USB\VID_xxxx&PID_yyyy" to the end of the line. +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[DeviceList] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2062&MI_00 + +[DeviceList.NTx86] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2062&MI_00 + +[DeviceList.NTamd64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2062&MI_00 + +[DeviceList.NTia64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2062&MI_00 + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; String Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +;Modify these strings to customize your device +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[Strings] +MFGNAME="http://www.lufa-lib.org" +DESCRIPTION="LUFA CDC-ACM Virtual Serial Port"
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/VirtualSerialMouse.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/VirtualSerialMouse.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1349580604 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/VirtualSerialMouse.c @@ -0,0 +1,282 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the VirtualSerialMouse demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "VirtualSerialMouse.h" + +/** LUFA CDC Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all CDC Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .ControlInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + }, + }; + +/** Buffer to hold the previously generated Mouse HID report, for comparison purposes inside the HID class driver. */ +static uint8_t PrevMouseHIDReportBuffer[sizeof(USB_MouseReport_Data_t)]; + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t Mouse_HID_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Mouse, + .ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Address = MOUSE_EPADDR, + .Size = MOUSE_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .PrevReportINBuffer = PrevMouseHIDReportBuffer, + .PrevReportINBufferSize = sizeof(PrevMouseHIDReportBuffer), + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + CheckJoystickMovement(); + + /* Must throw away unused bytes from the host, or it will lock up while waiting for the device */ + CDC_Device_ReceiveByte(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + + CDC_Device_USBTask(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + HID_Device_USBTask(&Mouse_HID_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Joystick_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Checks for changes in the position of the board joystick, sending strings to the host upon each change. */ +void CheckJoystickMovement(void) +{ + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + char* ReportString = NULL; + static bool ActionSent = false; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + ReportString = "Joystick Up\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + ReportString = "Joystick Down\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + ReportString = "Joystick Left\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + ReportString = "Joystick Right\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + ReportString = "Joystick Pressed\r\n"; + else + ActionSent = false; + + if ((ReportString != NULL) && (ActionSent == false)) + { + ActionSent = true; + + CDC_Device_SendString(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface, ReportString); + } +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= HID_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Mouse_HID_Interface); + ConfigSuccess &= CDC_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + + USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + CDC_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + HID_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Mouse_HID_Interface); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB device Start Of Frame event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void) +{ + HID_Device_MillisecondElapsed(&Mouse_HID_Interface); +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the creation of HID reports to the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in,out] ReportID Report ID requested by the host if non-zero, otherwise callback should set to the generated report ID + * \param[in] ReportType Type of the report to create, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_In or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[out] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the created report should be stored + * \param[out] ReportSize Number of bytes written in the report (or zero if no report is to be sent) + * + * \return Boolean \c true to force the sending of the report, \c false to let the library determine if it needs to be sent + */ +bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize) +{ + USB_MouseReport_Data_t* MouseReport = (USB_MouseReport_Data_t*)ReportData; + + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + uint8_t ButtonStatus_LCL = Buttons_GetStatus(); + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + MouseReport->Y = -1; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + MouseReport->Y = 1; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + MouseReport->X = -1; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + MouseReport->X = 1; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + MouseReport->Button |= (1 << 0); + + if (ButtonStatus_LCL & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) + MouseReport->Button |= (1 << 1); + + *ReportSize = sizeof(USB_MouseReport_Data_t); + return true; +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the processing of HID reports from the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in] ReportID Report ID of the received report from the host + * \param[in] ReportType The type of report that the host has sent, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_Out or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[in] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the received report has been stored + * \param[in] ReportSize Size in bytes of the received HID report + */ +void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize) +{ + // Unused (but mandatory for the HID class driver) in this demo, since there are no Host->Device reports +} + +/** CDC class driver callback function the processing of changes to the virtual + * control lines sent from the host.. + * + * \param[in] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to the CDC class interface configuration structure being referenced + */ +void EVENT_CDC_Device_ControLineStateChanged(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t *const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + /* You can get changes to the virtual CDC lines in this callback; a common + use-case is to use the Data Terminal Ready (DTR) flag to enable and + disable CDC communications in your application when set to avoid the + application blocking while waiting for a host to become ready and read + in the pending data from the USB endpoints. + */ + bool HostReady = (CDCInterfaceInfo->State.ControlLineStates.HostToDevice & CDC_CONTROL_LINE_OUT_DTR) != 0; +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/VirtualSerialMouse.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/VirtualSerialMouse.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0b8a035686 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/VirtualSerialMouse.h @@ -0,0 +1,88 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for VirtualSerialMouse.c. + */ + +#ifndef _VIRTUALSERIAL_MOUSE_H_ +#define _VIRTUALSERIAL_MOUSE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void CheckJoystickMovement(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void); + + bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize); + void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize); +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/VirtualSerialMouse.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/VirtualSerialMouse.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..97ba8714e1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/VirtualSerialMouse.txt @@ -0,0 +1,79 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Combined Communications Device Class (Virtual Serial Port) and Mouse Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC) \n + * Human Interface Device Class (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Abstract Control Model (ACM) \n + * Mouse Subclass</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF CDC Class Standard</td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Combined Communications Device Class/Mouse demonstration application. + * This gives a simple reference application for implementing a combined + * CDC and HID device acting as a both a virtual serial port and a mouse. + * Joystick actions are transmitted to the host as strings and as mouse + * movements. The device does not respond to serial data sent from the host. + * + * After running this demo for the first time on a new computer, + * you will need to supply the .INF file located in this demo + * project's directory as the device's driver when running under + * Windows. This will enable Windows to use its inbuilt CDC drivers, + * negating the need for custom drivers for the device. Other + * Operating Systems should automatically use their own inbuilt + * CDC-ACM drivers. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..40d13050b8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,64 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Virtual Serial CDC and Mouse HID Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.cdc_mouse.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.cdc_mouse"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Virtual Serial CDC and Mouse HID Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.class.cdc_mouse.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.class.cdc_mouse"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.class.cdc_mouse" caption="Virtual Serial CDC and Mouse HID Device Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Virtual Serial and Mouse device demo, implementing a virtual serial channel between the host PC and the device, and a USB mouse. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="CDC Class"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="VirtualSerialMouse.txt"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="LUFA VirtualSerialMouse.inf"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="VirtualSerialMouse.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="VirtualSerialMouse.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..36c6a6ecc0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Combined Virtual Serial and Mouse Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5272b2b96b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialMouse/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = VirtualSerialMouse +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a713c9d4cc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/ClassDriver/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,46 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +# Makefile to build all the LUFA Device Demos. Call with "make all" to +# rebuild all Device demos. + +# Projects are pre-cleaned before each one is built, to ensure any +# custom LUFA library build options are reflected in the compiled +# code. + +PROJECT_DIRECTORIES := $(shell ls -d */) + +# This makefile is potentially infinitely recursive if something really bad +# happens when determining the set of project directories - hard-abort if +# more than 10 levels deep to avoid angry emails. +ifeq ($(MAKELEVEL), 10) + $(error EMERGENCY ABORT: INFINITE RECURSION DETECTED) +endif + +# Need to special-case building without a per-project object directory +ifeq ($(OBJDIR),) + # If no target specified, force "clean all" and disallow parallel build + ifeq ($(MAKECMDGOALS),) + MAKECMDGOALS := clean all + .NOTPARALLEL: + endif + + # If one of the targets is to build, force "clean" beforehand and disallow parallel build + ifneq ($(findstring all, $(MAKECMDGOALS)),) + MAKECMDGOALS := clean $(MAKECMDGOALS) + .NOTPARALLEL: + endif +endif + +%: $(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES) + @echo . > /dev/null + +$(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES): + @$(MAKE) -C $@ $(MAKECMDGOALS) + +.PHONY: $(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES) diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/Incomplete/TestAndMeasurement/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/Incomplete/TestAndMeasurement/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0ec4635eb0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/Incomplete/TestAndMeasurement/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 4 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/Incomplete/TestAndMeasurement/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/Incomplete/TestAndMeasurement/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..96596c1619 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/Incomplete/TestAndMeasurement/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,205 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2010 Peter Lawrence (majbthrd [at] gmail [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = 0x00, + .SubClass = 0x00, + .Protocol = 0x00, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2065, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .TM_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_TestAndMeasurement, + .AlternateSetting = 0x00, + + .TotalEndpoints = 3, + + .Class = 0xFE, + .SubClass = 0x03, + .Protocol = 0x01, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .TM_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = TMC_OUT_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = TMC_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .TM_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = TMC_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = TMC_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .TM_NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = TMC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = TMC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0xFF + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA TMC Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/Incomplete/TestAndMeasurement/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/Incomplete/TestAndMeasurement/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..628b63a503 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/Incomplete/TestAndMeasurement/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,104 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2010 Peter Lawrence (majbthrd [at] gmail [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the TMC notification IN endpoint. */ + #define TMC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 2) + + /** Endpoint address of the TMC device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define TMC_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the TMC host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define TMC_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) + + /** Size in bytes of the TMC data endpoints. */ + #define TMC_IO_EPSIZE 64 + + /** Size in bytes of the TMC notification endpoint. */ + #define TMC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE 8 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Test and Measurement Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t TM_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t TM_DataOutEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t TM_DataInEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t TM_NotificationEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_TestAndMeasurement = 0, /**< Test and measurement interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/Incomplete/TestAndMeasurement/TestAndMeasurement.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/Incomplete/TestAndMeasurement/TestAndMeasurement.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c324be2d13 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/Incomplete/TestAndMeasurement/TestAndMeasurement.c @@ -0,0 +1,476 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "TestAndMeasurement.h" + +/** Contains the (usually static) capabilities of the TMC device. This table is requested by the + * host upon enumeration to give it information on what features of the Test and Measurement USB + * Class the device supports. + */ +TMC_Capabilities_t Capabilities = + { + .Status = TMC_STATUS_SUCCESS, + .TMCVersion = VERSION_BCD(1.00), + + .Interface = + { + .ListenOnly = false, + .TalkOnly = false, + .PulseIndicateSupported = false, + }, + + .Device = + { + .SupportsAbortINOnMatch = false, + }, + }; + +/** Current TMC control request that is being processed */ +static uint8_t RequestInProgress = 0; + +/** Stream callback abort flag for bulk IN data */ +static bool IsTMCBulkINReset = false; + +/** Stream callback abort flag for bulk OUT data */ +static bool IsTMCBulkOUTReset = false; + +/** Last used tag value for data transfers */ +static uint8_t CurrentTransferTag = 0; + +/** Length of last data transfer, for reporting to the host in case an in-progress transfer is aborted */ +static uint16_t LastTransferLength = 0; + +/** Buffer to hold the next message to sent to the TMC host */ +static uint8_t NextResponseBuffer[64]; + +/** Indicates the length of the next response to send */ +static uint8_t NextResponseLen; + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + TMC_Task(); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via + * the status LEDs and stops the USB management and CDC management tasks. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This is fired when the host set the current configuration + * of the USB device after enumeration - the device endpoints are configured and the CDC management task started. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + /* Setup TMC In, Out and Notification Endpoints */ + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(TMC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, TMC_IO_EPSIZE, 1); + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(TMC_IN_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, TMC_IO_EPSIZE, 1); + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(TMC_OUT_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, TMC_IO_EPSIZE, 1); + + /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to + * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing + * internally. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + uint8_t TMCRequestStatus = TMC_STATUS_SUCCESS; + + /* Process TMC specific control requests */ + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case Req_InitiateAbortBulkOut: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_ENDPOINT)) + { + /* Check that no split transaction is already in progress and the data transfer tag is valid */ + if (RequestInProgress != 0) + { + TMCRequestStatus = TMC_STATUS_SPLIT_IN_PROGRESS; + } + else if (USB_ControlRequest.wValue != CurrentTransferTag) + { + TMCRequestStatus = TMC_STATUS_TRANSFER_NOT_IN_PROGRESS; + } + else + { + /* Indicate that all in-progress/pending data OUT requests should be aborted */ + IsTMCBulkOUTReset = true; + + /* Save the split request for later checking when a new request is received */ + RequestInProgress = Req_InitiateAbortBulkOut; + } + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Write the request response byte */ + Endpoint_Write_8(TMCRequestStatus); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + case Req_CheckAbortBulkOutStatus: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_ENDPOINT)) + { + /* Check that an ABORT BULK OUT transaction has been requested and that the request has completed */ + if (RequestInProgress != Req_InitiateAbortBulkOut) + TMCRequestStatus = TMC_STATUS_SPLIT_NOT_IN_PROGRESS; + else if (IsTMCBulkOUTReset) + TMCRequestStatus = TMC_STATUS_PENDING; + else + RequestInProgress = 0; + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Write the request response bytes */ + Endpoint_Write_8(TMCRequestStatus); + Endpoint_Write_16_LE(0); + Endpoint_Write_32_LE(LastTransferLength); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + case Req_InitiateAbortBulkIn: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_ENDPOINT)) + { + /* Check that no split transaction is already in progress and the data transfer tag is valid */ + if (RequestInProgress != 0) + { + TMCRequestStatus = TMC_STATUS_SPLIT_IN_PROGRESS; + } + else if (USB_ControlRequest.wValue != CurrentTransferTag) + { + TMCRequestStatus = TMC_STATUS_TRANSFER_NOT_IN_PROGRESS; + } + else + { + /* Indicate that all in-progress/pending data IN requests should be aborted */ + IsTMCBulkINReset = true; + + /* Save the split request for later checking when a new request is received */ + RequestInProgress = Req_InitiateAbortBulkIn; + } + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Write the request response bytes */ + Endpoint_Write_8(TMCRequestStatus); + Endpoint_Write_8(CurrentTransferTag); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + case Req_CheckAbortBulkInStatus: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_ENDPOINT)) + { + /* Check that an ABORT BULK IN transaction has been requested and that the request has completed */ + if (RequestInProgress != Req_InitiateAbortBulkIn) + TMCRequestStatus = TMC_STATUS_SPLIT_NOT_IN_PROGRESS; + else if (IsTMCBulkINReset) + TMCRequestStatus = TMC_STATUS_PENDING; + else + RequestInProgress = 0; + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Write the request response bytes */ + Endpoint_Write_8(TMCRequestStatus); + Endpoint_Write_16_LE(0); + Endpoint_Write_32_LE(LastTransferLength); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + case Req_InitiateClear: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + /* Check that no split transaction is already in progress */ + if (RequestInProgress != 0) + { + Endpoint_Write_8(TMC_STATUS_SPLIT_IN_PROGRESS); + } + else + { + /* Indicate that all in-progress/pending data IN and OUT requests should be aborted */ + IsTMCBulkINReset = true; + IsTMCBulkOUTReset = true; + + /* Save the split request for later checking when a new request is received */ + RequestInProgress = Req_InitiateClear; + } + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Write the request response byte */ + Endpoint_Write_8(TMCRequestStatus); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + case Req_CheckClearStatus: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + /* Check that a CLEAR transaction has been requested and that the request has completed */ + if (RequestInProgress != Req_InitiateClear) + TMCRequestStatus = TMC_STATUS_SPLIT_NOT_IN_PROGRESS; + else if (IsTMCBulkINReset || IsTMCBulkOUTReset) + TMCRequestStatus = TMC_STATUS_PENDING; + else + RequestInProgress = 0; + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Write the request response bytes */ + Endpoint_Write_8(TMCRequestStatus); + Endpoint_Write_8(0); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + case Req_GetCapabilities: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Write the device capabilities to the control endpoint */ + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(&Capabilities, sizeof(TMC_Capabilities_t)); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + + break; + } +} + +void ProcessSentMessage(uint8_t* const Data, const uint8_t Length) +{ + if (strncmp((char*)Data, "*IDN?", 5) == 0) + strcpy((char*)NextResponseBuffer, "LUFA TMC DEMO"); + + NextResponseLen = strlen((char*)NextResponseBuffer); +} + +uint8_t GetNextMessage(uint8_t* const Data) +{ + strcpy((char*)NextResponseBuffer, "LUFA TMC DEMO"); + + NextResponseLen = strlen((char*)NextResponseBuffer); +// --- + uint8_t DataLen = MIN(NextResponseLen, 64); + + strlcpy((char*)Data, (char*)NextResponseBuffer, DataLen); + + return DataLen; +} + +/** Function to manage TMC data transmission and reception to and from the host. */ +void TMC_Task(void) +{ + /* Device must be connected and configured for the task to run */ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + TMC_MessageHeader_t MessageHeader; + uint8_t MessagePayload[128]; + + /* Try to read in a TMC message from the interface, process if one is available */ + if (ReadTMCHeader(&MessageHeader)) + { + /* Indicate busy */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + + switch (MessageHeader.MessageID) + { + case TMC_MESSAGEID_DEV_DEP_MSG_OUT: + LastTransferLength = 0; + while (Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(MessagePayload, MIN(MessageHeader.TransferSize, sizeof(MessagePayload)), &LastTransferLength) == + ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + { + if (IsTMCBulkOUTReset) + break; + } + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + ProcessSentMessage(MessagePayload, LastTransferLength); + break; + case TMC_MESSAGEID_DEV_DEP_MSG_IN: + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + MessageHeader.TransferSize = GetNextMessage(MessagePayload); + MessageHeader.MessageIDSpecific.DeviceOUT.LastMessageTransaction = true; + WriteTMCHeader(&MessageHeader); + + LastTransferLength = 0; + while (Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(MessagePayload, MessageHeader.TransferSize, &LastTransferLength) == + ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + { + if (IsTMCBulkINReset) + break; + } + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + break; + default: + Endpoint_StallTransaction(); + break; + } + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + } + + /* All pending data has been processed - reset the data abort flags */ + IsTMCBulkINReset = false; + IsTMCBulkOUTReset = false; +} + +/** Attempts to read in the TMC message header from the TMC interface. + * + * \param[out] MessageHeader Pointer to a location where the read header (if any) should be stored + * + * \return Boolean \c true if a header was read, \c false otherwise + */ +bool ReadTMCHeader(TMC_MessageHeader_t* const MessageHeader) +{ + uint16_t BytesTransferred; + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Select the Data Out endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(TMC_OUT_EPADDR); + + /* Abort if no command has been sent from the host */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) + return false; + + /* Read in the header of the command from the host */ + BytesTransferred = 0; + while ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(MessageHeader, sizeof(TMC_MessageHeader_t), &BytesTransferred)) == + ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + { + if (IsTMCBulkOUTReset) + break; + } + + /* Store the new command tag value for later use */ + CurrentTransferTag = MessageHeader->Tag; + + /* Indicate if the command has been aborted or not */ + return (!(IsTMCBulkOUTReset) && (ErrorCode == ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError)); +} + +bool WriteTMCHeader(TMC_MessageHeader_t* const MessageHeader) +{ + uint16_t BytesTransferred; + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Set the message tag of the command header */ + MessageHeader->Tag = CurrentTransferTag; + MessageHeader->InverseTag = ~CurrentTransferTag; + + /* Select the Data In endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(TMC_IN_EPADDR); + + /* Send the command header to the host */ + BytesTransferred = 0; + while ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(MessageHeader, sizeof(TMC_MessageHeader_t), &BytesTransferred)) == + ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + { + if (IsTMCBulkINReset) + break; + } + + /* Indicate if the command has been aborted or not */ + return (!(IsTMCBulkINReset) && (ErrorCode == ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError)); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/Incomplete/TestAndMeasurement/TestAndMeasurement.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/Incomplete/TestAndMeasurement/TestAndMeasurement.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..50e865bedd --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/Incomplete/TestAndMeasurement/TestAndMeasurement.h @@ -0,0 +1,150 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#ifndef _TESTANDMEASUREMENT_H_ +#define _TESTANDMEASUREMENT_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 + + #define Req_InitiateAbortBulkOut 0x01 + #define Req_CheckAbortBulkOutStatus 0x02 + #define Req_InitiateAbortBulkIn 0x03 + #define Req_CheckAbortBulkInStatus 0x04 + #define Req_InitiateClear 0x05 + #define Req_CheckClearStatus 0x06 + #define Req_GetCapabilities 0x07 + #define Req_IndicatorPulse 0x40 + + #define TMC_STATUS_SUCCESS 0x01 + #define TMC_STATUS_PENDING 0x02 + #define TMC_STATUS_FAILED 0x80 + #define TMC_STATUS_TRANSFER_NOT_IN_PROGRESS 0x81 + #define TMC_STATUS_SPLIT_NOT_IN_PROGRESS 0x82 + #define TMC_STATUS_SPLIT_IN_PROGRESS 0x83 + + #define TMC_MESSAGEID_DEV_DEP_MSG_OUT 0x01 + #define TMC_MESSAGEID_DEV_DEP_MSG_IN 0x02 + #define TMC_MESSAGEID_DEV_VENDOR_OUT 0x7E + #define TMC_MESSAGEID_DEV_VENDOR_IN 0x7F + + /* Type Defines */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Status; + uint8_t Reserved; + + uint16_t TMCVersion; + + struct + { + unsigned ListenOnly : 1; + unsigned TalkOnly : 1; + unsigned PulseIndicateSupported : 1; + unsigned Reserved : 5; + } Interface; + + struct + { + unsigned SupportsAbortINOnMatch : 1; + unsigned Reserved : 7; + } Device; + + uint8_t Reserved2[6]; + uint8_t Reserved3[12]; + } TMC_Capabilities_t; + + typedef struct + { + uint8_t LastMessageTransaction; + uint8_t TermChar; + uint8_t Reserved[2]; + } TMC_DevOUTMessageHeader_t; + + typedef struct + { + uint8_t LastMessageTransaction; + uint8_t Reserved[3]; + } TMC_DevINMessageHeader_t; + + typedef struct + { + uint8_t MessageID; + uint8_t Tag; + uint8_t InverseTag; + uint8_t Reserved; + uint32_t TransferSize; + + union + { + TMC_DevOUTMessageHeader_t DeviceOUT; + TMC_DevINMessageHeader_t DeviceIN; + uint32_t VendorSpecific; + } MessageIDSpecific; + } TMC_MessageHeader_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void TMC_Task(void); + bool ReadTMCHeader(TMC_MessageHeader_t* const MessageHeader); + bool WriteTMCHeader(TMC_MessageHeader_t* const MessageHeader); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/Incomplete/TestAndMeasurement/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/Incomplete/TestAndMeasurement/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e0d89ccd70 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/Incomplete/TestAndMeasurement/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = TestAndMeasurement +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/AudioInput.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/AudioInput.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2cf2414663 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/AudioInput.c @@ -0,0 +1,259 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the Audio Input demo. This file contains the main tasks of the demo and + * is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "AudioInput.h" + +/** Flag to indicate if the streaming audio alternative interface has been selected by the host. */ +static bool StreamingAudioInterfaceSelected = false; + +/** Current audio sampling frequency of the streaming audio endpoint. */ +static uint32_t CurrentAudioSampleFrequency = 48000; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + Buttons_Init(); + ADC_Init(ADC_FREE_RUNNING | ADC_PRESCALE_32); + ADC_SetupChannel(MIC_IN_ADC_CHANNEL); + USB_Init(); + + /* Start the ADC conversion in free running mode */ + ADC_StartReading(ADC_REFERENCE_AVCC | ADC_RIGHT_ADJUSTED | ADC_GET_CHANNEL_MASK(MIC_IN_ADC_CHANNEL)); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs, and + * configures the sample update and PWM timers. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB enumerating */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + /* Sample reload timer initialization */ + TIMSK0 = (1 << OCIE0A); + OCR0A = ((F_CPU / 8 / CurrentAudioSampleFrequency) - 1); + TCCR0A = (1 << WGM01); // CTC mode + TCCR0B = (1 << CS01); // Fcpu/8 speed +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via + * the status LEDs, disables the sample update and PWM output timers and stops the USB and Audio management tasks. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + /* Stop the sample reload timer */ + TCCR0B = 0; + + /* Indicate streaming audio interface not selected */ + StreamingAudioInterfaceSelected = false; + + /* Indicate USB not ready */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This is fired when the host set the current configuration + * of the USB device after enumeration - the device endpoints are configured. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + /* Setup Audio Stream Endpoint */ + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(AUDIO_STREAM_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS, AUDIO_STREAM_EPSIZE, 2); + + /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to + * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing + * internally. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + /* Process General and Audio specific control requests */ + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case REQ_SetInterface: + /* Set Interface is not handled by the library, as its function is application-specific */ + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + /* Check if the host is enabling the audio interface (setting AlternateSetting to 1) */ + StreamingAudioInterfaceSelected = ((USB_ControlRequest.wValue) != 0); + } + + break; + case AUDIO_REQ_GetStatus: + /* Get Status request can be directed at either the interface or endpoint, neither is currently used + * according to the latest USB Audio 1.0 standard, but must be ACKed with no data when requested */ + if ((USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) || + (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_ENDPOINT))) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + case AUDIO_REQ_SetCurrent: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_ENDPOINT)) + { + /* Extract out the relevant request information to get the target Endpoint address and control being set */ + uint8_t EndpointAddress = (uint8_t)USB_ControlRequest.wIndex; + uint8_t EndpointControl = (USB_ControlRequest.wValue >> 8); + + /* Only handle SET CURRENT requests to the audio endpoint's sample frequency property */ + if ((EndpointAddress == AUDIO_STREAM_EPADDR) && (EndpointControl == AUDIO_EPCONTROL_SamplingFreq)) + { + uint8_t SampleRate[3]; + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE(SampleRate, sizeof(SampleRate)); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Set the new sampling frequency to the value given by the host */ + CurrentAudioSampleFrequency = (((uint32_t)SampleRate[2] << 16) | ((uint32_t)SampleRate[1] << 8) | (uint32_t)SampleRate[0]); + + /* Adjust sample reload timer to the new frequency */ + OCR0A = ((F_CPU / 8 / CurrentAudioSampleFrequency) - 1); + } + } + + break; + case AUDIO_REQ_GetCurrent: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_ENDPOINT)) + { + /* Extract out the relevant request information to get the target Endpoint address and control being retrieved */ + uint8_t EndpointAddress = (uint8_t)USB_ControlRequest.wIndex; + uint8_t EndpointControl = (USB_ControlRequest.wValue >> 8); + + /* Only handle GET CURRENT requests to the audio endpoint's sample frequency property */ + if ((EndpointAddress == AUDIO_STREAM_EPADDR) && (EndpointControl == AUDIO_EPCONTROL_SamplingFreq)) + { + uint8_t SampleRate[3]; + + /* Convert the sampling rate value into the 24-bit format the host expects for the property */ + SampleRate[2] = (CurrentAudioSampleFrequency >> 16); + SampleRate[1] = (CurrentAudioSampleFrequency >> 8); + SampleRate[0] = (CurrentAudioSampleFrequency & 0xFF); + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(SampleRate, sizeof(SampleRate)); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + } + + break; + } +} + +/** ISR to handle the reloading of the data endpoint with the next sample. */ +ISR(TIMER0_COMPA_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + uint8_t PrevEndpoint = Endpoint_GetCurrentEndpoint(); + + /* Select the audio stream endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AUDIO_STREAM_EPADDR); + + /* Check if the current endpoint can be written to and that the audio interface is enabled */ + if (Endpoint_IsINReady() && StreamingAudioInterfaceSelected) + { + int16_t AudioSample; + + #if defined(USE_TEST_TONE) + static uint8_t SquareWaveSampleCount; + static int16_t CurrentWaveValue; + + /* In test tone mode, generate a square wave at 1/256 of the sample rate */ + if (SquareWaveSampleCount++ == 0xFF) + CurrentWaveValue ^= 0x8000; + + /* Only generate audio if the board button is being pressed */ + AudioSample = (Buttons_GetStatus() & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ? CurrentWaveValue : 0; + #else + /* Audio sample is ADC value scaled to fit the entire range */ + AudioSample = ((SAMPLE_MAX_RANGE / ADC_MAX_RANGE) * ADC_GetResult()); + + #if defined(MICROPHONE_BIASED_TO_HALF_RAIL) + /* Microphone is biased to half rail voltage, subtract the bias from the sample value */ + AudioSample -= (SAMPLE_MAX_RANGE / 2); + #endif + #endif + + /* Write the sample to the buffer */ + Endpoint_Write_16_LE(AudioSample); + + /* Check to see if the bank is now full */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + /* Send the full packet to the host */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } + } + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(PrevEndpoint); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/AudioInput.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/AudioInput.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..718df7cb7c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/AudioInput.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for AudioInput.c. + */ + +#ifndef _AUDIO_INPUT_H_ +#define _AUDIO_INPUT_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/ADC.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Maximum audio sample value for the microphone input. */ + #define SAMPLE_MAX_RANGE 0xFFFF + + /** Maximum ADC range for the microphone input. */ + #define ADC_MAX_RANGE 0x3FF + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/AudioInput.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/AudioInput.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9dc6c36b88 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/AudioInput.txt @@ -0,0 +1,87 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Audio Input Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Audio Class</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Standard Audio Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Audio 1.0 Class Specification \n + * USBIF Audio 1.0 Class Terminal Types Specification \n + * USBIF Audio 1.0 Data Formats Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Audio demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Audio Input device using the + * basic USB Audio 1.0 drivers in all modern OSes (i.e. no special drivers + * required). + * + * On start-up the system will automatically enumerate and function as a + * USB microphone. By default, the demo will produce a square wave test tone + * when the board button is pressed. If USE_TEST_TONE is not defined in the + * project makefile, incoming audio from the ADC channel 1 will be sampled + * and sent to the host computer instead. + * + * When in microphone mode, connect a microphone to the ADC channel 2. + * + * Under Windows, if a driver request dialogue pops up, select the option + * to automatically install the appropriate drivers. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>USE_TEST_TONE</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, this alters the demo to produce a square wave test tone when the first board button is pressed + * instead of sampling the board microphone.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MICROPHONE_BIASED_TO_HALF_RAIL</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, this alters the demo so that the half VCC bias of the microphone input is subtracted.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ff8ed270de --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,51 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define MIC_IN_ADC_CHANNEL 2 + + #define MICROPHONE_BIASED_TO_HALF_RAIL + #define USE_TEST_TONE + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6048c1d809 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..55e09244c0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,312 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2047, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,2), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .Audio_ControlInterface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioControl, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 0, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_ControlSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_ControlProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_ControlInterface_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .ACSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,0,0), + .TotalLength = (sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t) + + sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_InputTerminal_t) + + sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_OutputTerminal_t)), + + .InCollection = 1, + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + }, + + .Audio_InputTerminal = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_InputTerminal_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_InputTerminal, + + .TerminalID = 0x01, + .TerminalType = AUDIO_TERMINAL_IN_MIC, + .AssociatedOutputTerminal = 0x00, + + .TotalChannels = 1, + .ChannelConfig = 0, + + .ChannelStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + .TerminalStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_OutputTerminal = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_OutputTerminal_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_OutputTerminal, + + .TerminalID = 0x02, + .TerminalType = AUDIO_TERMINAL_STREAMING, + .AssociatedInputTerminal = 0x00, + + .SourceID = 0x01, + + .TerminalStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface_Alt0 = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 0, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioStreamingSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_StreamingProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface_Alt1 = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + .AlternateSetting = 1, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioStreamingSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_StreamingProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AS_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_General, + + .TerminalLink = 0x02, + + .FrameDelay = 1, + .AudioFormat = 0x0001 + }, + + .Audio_AudioFormat = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Format_t) + + sizeof(ConfigurationDescriptor.Audio_AudioFormatSampleRates), + .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_FormatType, + + .FormatType = 0x01, + .Channels = 0x01, + + .SubFrameSize = 0x02, + .BitResolution = 16, + + .TotalDiscreteSampleRates = (sizeof(ConfigurationDescriptor.Audio_AudioFormatSampleRates) / sizeof(USB_Audio_SampleFreq_t)), + }, + + .Audio_AudioFormatSampleRates = + { + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(8000), + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(11025), + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(22050), + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(44100), + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(48000), + }, + + .Audio_StreamEndpoint = + { + .Endpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = AUDIO_STREAM_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS | ENDPOINT_ATTR_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = AUDIO_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x01 + }, + + .Refresh = 0, + .SyncEndpointNumber = 0 + }, + + .Audio_StreamEndpoint_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Spc_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSEndpoint}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSEndpoint_General, + + .Attributes = (AUDIO_EP_ACCEPTS_SMALL_PACKETS | AUDIO_EP_SAMPLE_FREQ_CONTROL), + + .LockDelayUnits = 0x00, + .LockDelay = 0x0000 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Audio In Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cf832efb96 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,106 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Audio isochronous streaming data IN endpoint. */ + #define AUDIO_STREAM_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Endpoint size in bytes of the Audio isochronous streaming data endpoint. */ + #define AUDIO_STREAM_EPSIZE 256 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Audio Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_ControlInterface; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t Audio_ControlInterface_SPC; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_InputTerminal_t Audio_InputTerminal; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_OutputTerminal_t Audio_OutputTerminal; + + // Audio Streaming Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_StreamInterface_Alt0; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_StreamInterface_Alt1; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AS_t Audio_StreamInterface_SPC; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_Format_t Audio_AudioFormat; + USB_Audio_SampleFreq_t Audio_AudioFormatSampleRates[5]; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t Audio_StreamEndpoint; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Spc_t Audio_StreamEndpoint_SPC; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_AudioControl = 0, /**< Audio control interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream = 1, /**< Audio stream interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dab549a75c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,52 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Audio Input Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.audio_input.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.audio_input"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.audio_input" caption="Audio Input Device Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Audio 1.0 Input device demo, implementing a basic USB microphone. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="Audio Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="AudioInput.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="AudioInput.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="AudioInput.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.adc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d52d22cdcb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Audio Input Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..694e7fb1ab --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioInput/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = AudioInput +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7966ba6ea2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.c @@ -0,0 +1,293 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the AudioOutput demo. This file contains the main tasks of the demo and + * is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "AudioOutput.h" + +/** Flag to indicate if the streaming audio alternative interface has been selected by the host. */ +static bool StreamingAudioInterfaceSelected = false; + +/** Current audio sampling frequency of the streaming audio endpoint. */ +static uint32_t CurrentAudioSampleFrequency = 48000; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs, and + * configures the sample update and PWM timers. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB enumerating */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + /* Sample reload timer initialization */ + TIMSK0 = (1 << OCIE0A); + OCR0A = ((F_CPU / 8 / CurrentAudioSampleFrequency) - 1); + TCCR0A = (1 << WGM01); // CTC mode + TCCR0B = (1 << CS01); // Fcpu/8 speed + + #if defined(AUDIO_OUT_MONO) + /* Set speaker as output */ + DDRC |= (1 << 6); + #elif defined(AUDIO_OUT_STEREO) + /* Set speakers as outputs */ + DDRC |= ((1 << 6) | (1 << 5)); + #elif defined(AUDIO_OUT_PORTC) + /* Set PORTC as outputs */ + DDRC |= 0xFF; + #endif + + #if (defined(AUDIO_OUT_MONO) || defined(AUDIO_OUT_STEREO)) + /* PWM speaker timer initialization */ + TCCR3A = ((1 << WGM30) | (1 << COM3A1) | (1 << COM3A0) + | (1 << COM3B1) | (1 << COM3B0)); // Set on match, clear on TOP + TCCR3B = ((1 << WGM32) | (1 << CS30)); // Fast 8-Bit PWM, F_CPU speed + #endif +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via + * the status LEDs, disables the sample update and PWM output timers and stops the USB and Audio management tasks. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + /* Stop the timers */ + TCCR0B = 0; + #if (defined(AUDIO_OUT_MONO) || defined(AUDIO_OUT_STEREO)) + TCCR3B = 0; + #endif + + #if defined(AUDIO_OUT_MONO) + /* Set speaker as input to reduce current draw */ + DDRC &= ~(1 << 6); + #elif defined(AUDIO_OUT_STEREO) + /* Set speakers as inputs to reduce current draw */ + DDRC &= ~((1 << 6) | (1 << 5)); + #elif defined(AUDIO_OUT_PORTC) + /* Set PORTC low */ + PORTC = 0x00; + #endif + + /* Indicate streaming audio interface not selected */ + StreamingAudioInterfaceSelected = false; + + /* Indicate USB not ready */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This is fired when the host set the current configuration + * of the USB device after enumeration - the device endpoints are configured. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + /* Setup Audio Stream Endpoint */ + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(AUDIO_STREAM_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS, AUDIO_STREAM_EPSIZE, 2); + + /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to + * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing + * internally. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + /* Process General and Audio specific control requests */ + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case REQ_SetInterface: + /* Set Interface is not handled by the library, as its function is application-specific */ + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + /* Check if the host is enabling the audio interface (setting AlternateSetting to 1) */ + StreamingAudioInterfaceSelected = ((USB_ControlRequest.wValue) != 0); + } + + break; + case AUDIO_REQ_GetStatus: + /* Get Status request can be directed at either the interface or endpoint, neither is currently used + * according to the latest USB Audio 1.0 standard, but must be ACKed with no data when requested */ + if ((USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) || + (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_ENDPOINT))) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + case AUDIO_REQ_SetCurrent: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_ENDPOINT)) + { + /* Extract out the relevant request information to get the target Endpoint address and control being set */ + uint8_t EndpointAddress = (uint8_t)USB_ControlRequest.wIndex; + uint8_t EndpointControl = (USB_ControlRequest.wValue >> 8); + + /* Only handle SET CURRENT requests to the audio endpoint's sample frequency property */ + if ((EndpointAddress == AUDIO_STREAM_EPADDR) && (EndpointControl == AUDIO_EPCONTROL_SamplingFreq)) + { + uint8_t SampleRate[3]; + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE(SampleRate, sizeof(SampleRate)); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Set the new sampling frequency to the value given by the host */ + CurrentAudioSampleFrequency = (((uint32_t)SampleRate[2] << 16) | ((uint32_t)SampleRate[1] << 8) | (uint32_t)SampleRate[0]); + + /* Adjust sample reload timer to the new frequency */ + OCR0A = ((F_CPU / 8 / CurrentAudioSampleFrequency) - 1); + } + } + + break; + case AUDIO_REQ_GetCurrent: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_ENDPOINT)) + { + /* Extract out the relevant request information to get the target Endpoint address and control being retrieved */ + uint8_t EndpointAddress = (uint8_t)USB_ControlRequest.wIndex; + uint8_t EndpointControl = (USB_ControlRequest.wValue >> 8); + + /* Only handle GET CURRENT requests to the audio endpoint's sample frequency property */ + if ((EndpointAddress == AUDIO_STREAM_EPADDR) && (EndpointControl == AUDIO_EPCONTROL_SamplingFreq)) + { + uint8_t SampleRate[3]; + + /* Convert the sampling rate value into the 24-bit format the host expects for the property */ + SampleRate[2] = (CurrentAudioSampleFrequency >> 16); + SampleRate[1] = (CurrentAudioSampleFrequency >> 8); + SampleRate[0] = (CurrentAudioSampleFrequency & 0xFF); + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(SampleRate, sizeof(SampleRate)); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + } + + break; + } +} + +/** ISR to handle the reloading of the PWM timer with the next sample. */ +ISR(TIMER0_COMPA_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + uint8_t PrevEndpoint = Endpoint_GetCurrentEndpoint(); + + /* Select the audio stream endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AUDIO_STREAM_EPADDR); + + /* Check if the current endpoint can be read from (contains a packet) and the host is sending data */ + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived() && StreamingAudioInterfaceSelected) + { + /* Retrieve the signed 16-bit left and right audio samples, convert to 8-bit */ + int8_t LeftSample_8Bit = ((int16_t)Endpoint_Read_16_LE() >> 8); + int8_t RightSample_8Bit = ((int16_t)Endpoint_Read_16_LE() >> 8); + + /* Mix the two channels together to produce a mono, 8-bit sample */ + int8_t MixedSample_8Bit = (((int16_t)LeftSample_8Bit + (int16_t)RightSample_8Bit) >> 1); + + /* Check to see if the bank is now empty */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + /* Acknowledge the packet, clear the bank ready for the next packet */ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + + #if defined(AUDIO_OUT_MONO) + /* Load the sample into the PWM timer channel */ + OCR3A = (MixedSample_8Bit ^ (1 << 7)); + #elif defined(AUDIO_OUT_STEREO) + /* Load the dual 8-bit samples into the PWM timer channels */ + OCR3A = (LeftSample_8Bit ^ (1 << 7)); + OCR3B = (RightSample_8Bit ^ (1 << 7)); + #elif defined(AUDIO_OUT_PORTC) + /* Load the 8-bit mixed sample into PORTC */ + PORTC = MixedSample_8Bit; + #endif + + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS; + + /* Turn on LEDs as the sample amplitude increases */ + if (MixedSample_8Bit > 16) + LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4); + else if (MixedSample_8Bit > 8) + LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3); + else if (MixedSample_8Bit > 4) + LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2); + else if (MixedSample_8Bit > 2) + LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); + } + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(PrevEndpoint); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..15c8c458d1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.h @@ -0,0 +1,74 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for AudioOutput.c. + */ + +#ifndef _AUDIO_OUTPUT_H_ +#define _AUDIO_OUTPUT_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8f0c7d656c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.txt @@ -0,0 +1,92 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Audio Output Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Audio Class</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Standard Audio Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Audio 1.0 Class Specification \n + * USBIF Audio 1.0 Class Terminal Types Specification \n + * USBIF Audio 1.0 Data Formats Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Audio demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Audio Output device using the + * basic USB Audio 1.0 drivers in all modern OSes (i.e. no special drivers + * required). + * + * On start-up the system will automatically enumerate and function + * as a USB speaker. Outgoing audio will output in 8-bit PWM onto + * the timer 3 output compare channel A for AUDIO_OUT_MONO mode, on + * timer 3 channels A and B for AUDIO_OUT_STEREO and on PORTC as a signed + * mono sample for AUDIO_OUT_PORTC. Audio output will also be indicated on + * the board LEDs in all modes. Decouple audio outputs with a capacitor and + * attach to a speaker to hear the audio. + * + * Under Windows, if a driver request dialogue pops up, select the option + * to automatically install the appropriate drivers. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AUDIO_OUT_STEREO</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, this outputs the audio samples in stereo to the timer output pins of the microcontroller.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AUDIO_OUT_MONO</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, this outputs the audio samples in mono to the timer output pin of the microcontroller.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AUDIO_OUT_PORTC</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, this outputs the audio samples in mono to port C of the microcontroller, for connection to an + * external DAC.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e93cfc8136 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define AUDIO_OUT_STEREO +// #define AUDIO_OUT_MONO +// #define AUDIO_OUT_PORTC + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6048c1d809 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..64be54bf07 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,312 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2046, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,2), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .Audio_ControlInterface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioControl, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 0, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_ControlSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_ControlProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_ControlInterface_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .ACSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,0,0), + .TotalLength = (sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t) + + sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_InputTerminal_t) + + sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_OutputTerminal_t)), + + .InCollection = 1, + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + }, + + .Audio_InputTerminal = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_InputTerminal_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_InputTerminal, + + .TerminalID = 0x01, + .TerminalType = AUDIO_TERMINAL_STREAMING, + .AssociatedOutputTerminal = 0x00, + + .TotalChannels = 2, + .ChannelConfig = (AUDIO_CHANNEL_LEFT_FRONT | AUDIO_CHANNEL_RIGHT_FRONT), + + .ChannelStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + .TerminalStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_OutputTerminal = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_OutputTerminal_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_OutputTerminal, + + .TerminalID = 0x02, + .TerminalType = AUDIO_TERMINAL_OUT_SPEAKER, + .AssociatedInputTerminal = 0x00, + + .SourceID = 0x01, + + .TerminalStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface_Alt0 = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 0, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioStreamingSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_StreamingProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface_Alt1 = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + .AlternateSetting = 1, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioStreamingSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_StreamingProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AS_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_General, + + .TerminalLink = 0x01, + + .FrameDelay = 1, + .AudioFormat = 0x0001 + }, + + .Audio_AudioFormat = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Format_t) + + sizeof(ConfigurationDescriptor.Audio_AudioFormatSampleRates), + .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_FormatType, + + .FormatType = 0x01, + .Channels = 0x02, + + .SubFrameSize = 0x02, + .BitResolution = 16, + + .TotalDiscreteSampleRates = (sizeof(ConfigurationDescriptor.Audio_AudioFormatSampleRates) / sizeof(USB_Audio_SampleFreq_t)), + }, + + .Audio_AudioFormatSampleRates = + { + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(8000), + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(11025), + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(22050), + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(44100), + AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(48000), + }, + + .Audio_StreamEndpoint = + { + .Endpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = AUDIO_STREAM_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS | ENDPOINT_ATTR_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = AUDIO_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x01 + }, + + .Refresh = 0, + .SyncEndpointNumber = 0 + }, + + .Audio_StreamEndpoint_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Spc_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSEndpoint}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSEndpoint_General, + + .Attributes = (AUDIO_EP_ACCEPTS_SMALL_PACKETS | AUDIO_EP_SAMPLE_FREQ_CONTROL), + + .LockDelayUnits = 0x00, + .LockDelay = 0x0000 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Audio Out Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d9be070fad --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,106 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Audio isochronous streaming data OUT endpoint. */ + #define AUDIO_STREAM_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 1) + + /** Endpoint size in bytes of the Audio isochronous streaming data endpoint. */ + #define AUDIO_STREAM_EPSIZE 256 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Audio Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_ControlInterface; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t Audio_ControlInterface_SPC; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_InputTerminal_t Audio_InputTerminal; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_OutputTerminal_t Audio_OutputTerminal; + + // Audio Streaming Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_StreamInterface_Alt0; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_StreamInterface_Alt1; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AS_t Audio_StreamInterface_SPC; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_Format_t Audio_AudioFormat; + USB_Audio_SampleFreq_t Audio_AudioFormatSampleRates[5]; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t Audio_StreamEndpoint; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Spc_t Audio_StreamEndpoint_SPC; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_AudioControl = 0, /**< Audio control interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream = 1, /**< Audio stream interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cddfb85438 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,51 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Audio Output Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.audio_output.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.audio_output"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.audio_output" caption="Audio Output Device Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Audio 1.0 Output device demo, implementing a basic USB speaker. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="Audio Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="AudioOutput.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="AudioOutput.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="AudioOutput.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..937ef3907b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Audio Output Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = YES + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a0f34c4a4c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/AudioOutput/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = AudioOutput +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/BulkVendor.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/BulkVendor.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fe7ad84bbb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/BulkVendor.c @@ -0,0 +1,136 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the Bulk Vendor demo. This file contains the main tasks of the demo and + * is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_BULKVENDOR_C +#include "BulkVendor.h" + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + USB_USBTask(); + + uint8_t ReceivedData[VENDOR_IO_EPSIZE]; + memset(ReceivedData, 0x00, sizeof(ReceivedData)); + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(VENDOR_OUT_EPADDR); + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + { + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(ReceivedData, VENDOR_IO_EPSIZE, NULL); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(VENDOR_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(ReceivedData, VENDOR_IO_EPSIZE, NULL); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB enumerating */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via + * the status LEDs. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB not ready */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This is fired when the host set the current configuration + * of the USB device after enumeration - the device endpoints are configured. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + /* Setup Vendor Data Endpoints */ + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(VENDOR_IN_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, VENDOR_IO_EPSIZE, 1); + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(VENDOR_OUT_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, VENDOR_IO_EPSIZE, 1); + + /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to + * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing + * internally. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + // Process vendor specific control requests here +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/BulkVendor.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/BulkVendor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3d74ac001a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/BulkVendor.h @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for BulkVendor.c. + */ + +#ifndef _BULK_VENDOR_H_ +#define _BULK_VENDOR_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/BulkVendor.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/BulkVendor.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d6688a9cdf --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/BulkVendor.txt @@ -0,0 +1,69 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Bulk Vendor Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Vendor (no official class)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Vendor (no official subclass)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>None</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Bulk Vendor demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB device that contains read/write bulk type + * endpoints, for implementing custom USB protocols. + * + * On start-up the system will automatically enumerate and echo back packets + * sent from the host. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0ec4635eb0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 4 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9a4c2792b5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,194 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x206C, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED, + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .Vendor_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Vendor, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = 0xFF, + .SubClass = 0xFF, + .Protocol = 0xFF, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Vendor_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = VENDOR_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = VENDOR_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .Vendor_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = VENDOR_OUT_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = VENDOR_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Bulk Vendor Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..939717ea3f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,96 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Bulk Vendor device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define VENDOR_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the Bulk Vendor host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define VENDOR_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) + + /** Size in bytes of the Bulk Vendor data endpoints. */ + #define VENDOR_IO_EPSIZE 64 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Vendor Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Vendor_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t Vendor_DataInEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t Vendor_DataOutEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_Vendor = 0, /**< Vendor interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/HostTestApp/test_bulk_vendor.py b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/HostTestApp/test_bulk_vendor.py new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fff8ecd780 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/HostTestApp/test_bulk_vendor.py @@ -0,0 +1,67 @@ +""" + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +""" + +""" + LUFA Bulk Vendor device demo host test script. This script will send and + receive a continuous stream of packets to/from to the device, to show + bidirectional communications. + + Requires the pyUSB library (http://sourceforge.net/projects/pyusb/). +""" + +import sys +from time import sleep +import usb.core +import usb.util + +# Bulk Vendor HID device VID and PID +device_vid = 0x03EB +device_pid = 0x206C +device_in_ep = 3 +device_out_ep = 4 + + +def get_vendor_device_handle(): + dev_handle = usb.core.find(idVendor=device_vid, idProduct=device_pid) + return dev_handle + + +def write(device, packet): + device.write(usb.util.ENDPOINT_OUT | device_out_ep, packet, 0, 1000) + print("Sent Packet: {0}".format(packet)) + + +def read(device): + packet = device.read(usb.util.ENDPOINT_IN | device_in_ep, 64, 0, 1000) + print("Received Packet: {0}".format(''.join([chr(x) for x in packet]))) + return packet + + +def main(): + vendor_device = get_vendor_device_handle() + + if vendor_device is None: + print("No valid Vendor device found.") + sys.exit(1) + + vendor_device.set_configuration() + + print("Connected to device 0x%04X/0x%04X - %s [%s]" % + (vendor_device.idVendor, vendor_device.idProduct, + usb.util.get_string(vendor_device, 255, vendor_device.iProduct), + usb.util.get_string(vendor_device, 255, vendor_device.iManufacturer))) + + x = 0 + while 1: + x = x + 1 % 255 + write(vendor_device, "TEST PACKET %d" % x) + read(vendor_device) + sleep(1) + +if __name__ == '__main__': + main() diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/LUFA_Bulk_Vendor_Demo.inf b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/LUFA_Bulk_Vendor_Demo.inf Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..32a29fdc50 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/LUFA_Bulk_Vendor_Demo.inf diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/amd64/libusb0.dll b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/amd64/libusb0.dll Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f916b08986 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/amd64/libusb0.dll diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/amd64/libusb0.sys b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/amd64/libusb0.sys Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0718dfb7c0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/amd64/libusb0.sys diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/ia64/libusb0.dll b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/ia64/libusb0.dll Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..292df27857 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/ia64/libusb0.dll diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/ia64/libusb0.sys b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/ia64/libusb0.sys Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f17914b8c4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/ia64/libusb0.sys diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/installer_x64.exe b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/installer_x64.exe Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c38919ee50 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/installer_x64.exe diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/installer_x86.exe b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/installer_x86.exe Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..030ec300c2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/installer_x86.exe diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/license/libusb0/installer_license.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/license/libusb0/installer_license.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..56bb2cda25 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/license/libusb0/installer_license.txt @@ -0,0 +1,851 @@ +Copyright (c) 2002-2004 Stephan Meyer, <ste_meyer@web.de> +Copyright (c) 2000-2004 Johannes Erdfelt, <johannes@erdfelt.com> +Copyright (c) 2000-2004 Thomas Sailer, <sailer@ife.ee.ethz.ch> +Copyright (c) 2010 Travis Robinson, <libusbdotnet@gmail.com> + +This software is distributed under the following licenses: +Driver: GNU General Public License (GPL) +Library, Test Files, Installer: GNU Lesser General Public License (LGPL) + +*********************************************************************** + GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE + Version 3, 29 June 2007 + + Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/> + Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies + of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. + + Preamble + + The GNU General Public License is a free, copyleft license for +software and other kinds of works. + + The licenses for most software and other practical works are designed +to take away your freedom to share and change the works. By contrast, +the GNU General Public License is intended to guarantee your freedom to +share and change all versions of a program--to make sure it remains free +software for all its users. We, the Free Software Foundation, use the +GNU General Public License for most of our software; it applies also to +any other work released this way by its authors. You can apply it to +your programs, too. + + When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not +price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you +have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for +them if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you +want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new +free programs, and that you know you can do these things. + + To protect your rights, we need to prevent others from denying you +these rights or asking you to surrender the rights. Therefore, you have +certain responsibilities if you distribute copies of the software, or if +you modify it: responsibilities to respect the freedom of others. + + For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether +gratis or for a fee, you must pass on to the recipients the same +freedoms that you received. You must make sure that they, too, receive +or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so they +know their rights. + + Developers that use the GNU GPL protect your rights with two steps: +(1) assert copyright on the software, and (2) offer you this License +giving you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify it. + + For the developers' and authors' protection, the GPL clearly explains +that there is no warranty for this free software. For both users' and +authors' sake, the GPL requires that modified versions be marked as +changed, so that their problems will not be attributed erroneously to +authors of previous versions. + + Some devices are designed to deny users access to install or run +modified versions of the software inside them, although the manufacturer +can do so. This is fundamentally incompatible with the aim of +protecting users' freedom to change the software. The systematic +pattern of such abuse occurs in the area of products for individuals to +use, which is precisely where it is most unacceptable. Therefore, we +have designed this version of the GPL to prohibit the practice for those +products. If such problems arise substantially in other domains, we +stand ready to extend this provision to those domains in future versions +of the GPL, as needed to protect the freedom of users. + + Finally, every program is threatened constantly by software patents. +States should not allow patents to restrict development and use of +software on general-purpose computers, but in those that do, we wish to +avoid the special danger that patents applied to a free program could +make it effectively proprietary. To prevent this, the GPL assures that +patents cannot be used to render the program non-free. + + The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and +modification follow. + + TERMS AND CONDITIONS + + 0. Definitions. + + "This License" refers to version 3 of the GNU General Public License. + + "Copyright" also means copyright-like laws that apply to other kinds of +works, such as semiconductor masks. + + "The Program" refers to any copyrightable work licensed under this +License. Each licensee is addressed as "you". "Licensees" and +"recipients" may be individuals or organizations. + + To "modify" a work means to copy from or adapt all or part of the work +in a fashion requiring copyright permission, other than the making of an +exact copy. The resulting work is called a "modified version" of the +earlier work or a work "based on" the earlier work. + + A "covered work" means either the unmodified Program or a work based +on the Program. + + To "propagate" a work means to do anything with it that, without +permission, would make you directly or secondarily liable for +infringement under applicable copyright law, except executing it on a +computer or modifying a private copy. Propagation includes copying, +distribution (with or without modification), making available to the +public, and in some countries other activities as well. + + To "convey" a work means any kind of propagation that enables other +parties to make or receive copies. Mere interaction with a user through +a computer network, with no transfer of a copy, is not conveying. + + An interactive user interface displays "Appropriate Legal Notices" +to the extent that it includes a convenient and prominently visible +feature that (1) displays an appropriate copyright notice, and (2) +tells the user that there is no warranty for the work (except to the +extent that warranties are provided), that licensees may convey the +work under this License, and how to view a copy of this License. If +the interface presents a list of user commands or options, such as a +menu, a prominent item in the list meets this criterion. + + 1. Source Code. + + The "source code" for a work means the preferred form of the work +for making modifications to it. "Object code" means any non-source +form of a work. + + A "Standard Interface" means an interface that either is an official +standard defined by a recognized standards body, or, in the case of +interfaces specified for a particular programming language, one that +is widely used among developers working in that language. + + The "System Libraries" of an executable work include anything, other +than the work as a whole, that (a) is included in the normal form of +packaging a Major Component, but which is not part of that Major +Component, and (b) serves only to enable use of the work with that +Major Component, or to implement a Standard Interface for which an +implementation is available to the public in source code form. A +"Major Component", in this context, means a major essential component +(kernel, window system, and so on) of the specific operating system +(if any) on which the executable work runs, or a compiler used to +produce the work, or an object code interpreter used to run it. + + The "Corresponding Source" for a work in object code form means all +the source code needed to generate, install, and (for an executable +work) run the object code and to modify the work, including scripts to +control those activities. However, it does not include the work's +System Libraries, or general-purpose tools or generally available free +programs which are used unmodified in performing those activities but +which are not part of the work. For example, Corresponding Source +includes interface definition files associated with source files for +the work, and the source code for shared libraries and dynamically +linked subprograms that the work is specifically designed to require, +such as by intimate data communication or control flow between those +subprograms and other parts of the work. + + The Corresponding Source need not include anything that users +can regenerate automatically from other parts of the Corresponding +Source. + + The Corresponding Source for a work in source code form is that +same work. + + 2. Basic Permissions. + + All rights granted under this License are granted for the term of +copyright on the Program, and are irrevocable provided the stated +conditions are met. This License explicitly affirms your unlimited +permission to run the unmodified Program. The output from running a +covered work is covered by this License only if the output, given its +content, constitutes a covered work. This License acknowledges your +rights of fair use or other equivalent, as provided by copyright law. + + You may make, run and propagate covered works that you do not +convey, without conditions so long as your license otherwise remains +in force. You may convey covered works to others for the sole purpose +of having them make modifications exclusively for you, or provide you +with facilities for running those works, provided that you comply with +the terms of this License in conveying all material for which you do +not control copyright. Those thus making or running the covered works +for you must do so exclusively on your behalf, under your direction +and control, on terms that prohibit them from making any copies of +your copyrighted material outside their relationship with you. + + Conveying under any other circumstances is permitted solely under +the conditions stated below. Sublicensing is not allowed; section 10 +makes it unnecessary. + + 3. Protecting Users' Legal Rights From Anti-Circumvention Law. + + No covered work shall be deemed part of an effective technological +measure under any applicable law fulfilling obligations under article +11 of the WIPO copyright treaty adopted on 20 December 1996, or +similar laws prohibiting or restricting circumvention of such +measures. + + When you convey a covered work, you waive any legal power to forbid +circumvention of technological measures to the extent such circumvention +is effected by exercising rights under this License with respect to +the covered work, and you disclaim any intention to limit operation or +modification of the work as a means of enforcing, against the work's +users, your or third parties' legal rights to forbid circumvention of +technological measures. + + 4. Conveying Verbatim Copies. + + You may convey verbatim copies of the Program's source code as you +receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and +appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice; +keep intact all notices stating that this License and any +non-permissive terms added in accord with section 7 apply to the code; +keep intact all notices of the absence of any warranty; and give all +recipients a copy of this License along with the Program. + + You may charge any price or no price for each copy that you convey, +and you may offer support or warranty protection for a fee. + + 5. Conveying Modified Source Versions. + + You may convey a work based on the Program, or the modifications to +produce it from the Program, in the form of source code under the +terms of section 4, provided that you also meet all of these conditions: + + a) The work must carry prominent notices stating that you modified + it, and giving a relevant date. + + b) The work must carry prominent notices stating that it is + released under this License and any conditions added under section + 7. This requirement modifies the requirement in section 4 to + "keep intact all notices". + + c) You must license the entire work, as a whole, under this + License to anyone who comes into possession of a copy. This + License will therefore apply, along with any applicable section 7 + additional terms, to the whole of the work, and all its parts, + regardless of how they are packaged. This License gives no + permission to license the work in any other way, but it does not + invalidate such permission if you have separately received it. + + d) If the work has interactive user interfaces, each must display + Appropriate Legal Notices; however, if the Program has interactive + interfaces that do not display Appropriate Legal Notices, your + work need not make them do so. + + A compilation of a covered work with other separate and independent +works, which are not by their nature extensions of the covered work, +and which are not combined with it such as to form a larger program, +in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an +"aggregate" if the compilation and its resulting copyright are not +used to limit the access or legal rights of the compilation's users +beyond what the individual works permit. Inclusion of a covered work +in an aggregate does not cause this License to apply to the other +parts of the aggregate. + + 6. Conveying Non-Source Forms. + + You may convey a covered work in object code form under the terms +of sections 4 and 5, provided that you also convey the +machine-readable Corresponding Source under the terms of this License, +in one of these ways: + + a) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product + (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by the + Corresponding Source fixed on a durable physical medium + customarily used for software interchange. + + b) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product + (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by a + written offer, valid for at least three years and valid for as + long as you offer spare parts or customer support for that product + model, to give anyone who possesses the object code either (1) a + copy of the Corresponding Source for all the software in the + product that is covered by this License, on a durable physical + medium customarily used for software interchange, for a price no + more than your reasonable cost of physically performing this + conveying of source, or (2) access to copy the + Corresponding Source from a network server at no charge. + + c) Convey individual copies of the object code with a copy of the + written offer to provide the Corresponding Source. This + alternative is allowed only occasionally and noncommercially, and + only if you received the object code with such an offer, in accord + with subsection 6b. + + d) Convey the object code by offering access from a designated + place (gratis or for a charge), and offer equivalent access to the + Corresponding Source in the same way through the same place at no + further charge. You need not require recipients to copy the + Corresponding Source along with the object code. If the place to + copy the object code is a network server, the Corresponding Source + may be on a different server (operated by you or a third party) + that supports equivalent copying facilities, provided you maintain + clear directions next to the object code saying where to find the + Corresponding Source. Regardless of what server hosts the + Corresponding Source, you remain obligated to ensure that it is + available for as long as needed to satisfy these requirements. + + e) Convey the object code using peer-to-peer transmission, provided + you inform other peers where the object code and Corresponding + Source of the work are being offered to the general public at no + charge under subsection 6d. + + A separable portion of the object code, whose source code is excluded +from the Corresponding Source as a System Library, need not be +included in conveying the object code work. + + A "User Product" is either (1) a "consumer product", which means any +tangible personal property which is normally used for personal, family, +or household purposes, or (2) anything designed or sold for incorporation +into a dwelling. In determining whether a product is a consumer product, +doubtful cases shall be resolved in favor of coverage. For a particular +product received by a particular user, "normally used" refers to a +typical or common use of that class of product, regardless of the status +of the particular user or of the way in which the particular user +actually uses, or expects or is expected to use, the product. A product +is a consumer product regardless of whether the product has substantial +commercial, industrial or non-consumer uses, unless such uses represent +the only significant mode of use of the product. + + "Installation Information" for a User Product means any methods, +procedures, authorization keys, or other information required to install +and execute modified versions of a covered work in that User Product from +a modified version of its Corresponding Source. The information must +suffice to ensure that the continued functioning of the modified object +code is in no case prevented or interfered with solely because +modification has been made. + + If you convey an object code work under this section in, or with, or +specifically for use in, a User Product, and the conveying occurs as +part of a transaction in which the right of possession and use of the +User Product is transferred to the recipient in perpetuity or for a +fixed term (regardless of how the transaction is characterized), the +Corresponding Source conveyed under this section must be accompanied +by the Installation Information. But this requirement does not apply +if neither you nor any third party retains the ability to install +modified object code on the User Product (for example, the work has +been installed in ROM). + + The requirement to provide Installation Information does not include a +requirement to continue to provide support service, warranty, or updates +for a work that has been modified or installed by the recipient, or for +the User Product in which it has been modified or installed. Access to a +network may be denied when the modification itself materially and +adversely affects the operation of the network or violates the rules and +protocols for communication across the network. + + Corresponding Source conveyed, and Installation Information provided, +in accord with this section must be in a format that is publicly +documented (and with an implementation available to the public in +source code form), and must require no special password or key for +unpacking, reading or copying. + + 7. Additional Terms. + + "Additional permissions" are terms that supplement the terms of this +License by making exceptions from one or more of its conditions. +Additional permissions that are applicable to the entire Program shall +be treated as though they were included in this License, to the extent +that they are valid under applicable law. If additional permissions +apply only to part of the Program, that part may be used separately +under those permissions, but the entire Program remains governed by +this License without regard to the additional permissions. + + When you convey a copy of a covered work, you may at your option +remove any additional permissions from that copy, or from any part of +it. (Additional permissions may be written to require their own +removal in certain cases when you modify the work.) You may place +additional permissions on material, added by you to a covered work, +for which you have or can give appropriate copyright permission. + + Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, for material you +add to a covered work, you may (if authorized by the copyright holders of +that material) supplement the terms of this License with terms: + + a) Disclaiming warranty or limiting liability differently from the + terms of sections 15 and 16 of this License; or + + b) Requiring preservation of specified reasonable legal notices or + author attributions in that material or in the Appropriate Legal + Notices displayed by works containing it; or + + c) Prohibiting misrepresentation of the origin of that material, or + requiring that modified versions of such material be marked in + reasonable ways as different from the original version; or + + d) Limiting the use for publicity purposes of names of licensors or + authors of the material; or + + e) Declining to grant rights under trademark law for use of some + trade names, trademarks, or service marks; or + + f) Requiring indemnification of licensors and authors of that + material by anyone who conveys the material (or modified versions of + it) with contractual assumptions of liability to the recipient, for + any liability that these contractual assumptions directly impose on + those licensors and authors. + + All other non-permissive additional terms are considered "further +restrictions" within the meaning of section 10. If the Program as you +received it, or any part of it, contains a notice stating that it is +governed by this License along with a term that is a further +restriction, you may remove that term. If a license document contains +a further restriction but permits relicensing or conveying under this +License, you may add to a covered work material governed by the terms +of that license document, provided that the further restriction does +not survive such relicensing or conveying. + + If you add terms to a covered work in accord with this section, you +must place, in the relevant source files, a statement of the +additional terms that apply to those files, or a notice indicating +where to find the applicable terms. + + Additional terms, permissive or non-permissive, may be stated in the +form of a separately written license, or stated as exceptions; +the above requirements apply either way. + + 8. Termination. + + You may not propagate or modify a covered work except as expressly +provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to propagate or +modify it is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under +this License (including any patent licenses granted under the third +paragraph of section 11). + + However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your +license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a) +provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and +finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright +holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means +prior to 60 days after the cessation. + + Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is +reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the +violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have +received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that +copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after +your receipt of the notice. + + Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the +licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under +this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently +reinstated, you do not qualify to receive new licenses for the same +material under section 10. + + 9. Acceptance Not Required for Having Copies. + + You are not required to accept this License in order to receive or +run a copy of the Program. Ancillary propagation of a covered work +occurring solely as a consequence of using peer-to-peer transmission +to receive a copy likewise does not require acceptance. However, +nothing other than this License grants you permission to propagate or +modify any covered work. These actions infringe copyright if you do +not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or propagating a +covered work, you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so. + + 10. Automatic Licensing of Downstream Recipients. + + Each time you convey a covered work, the recipient automatically +receives a license from the original licensors, to run, modify and +propagate that work, subject to this License. You are not responsible +for enforcing compliance by third parties with this License. + + An "entity transaction" is a transaction transferring control of an +organization, or substantially all assets of one, or subdividing an +organization, or merging organizations. If propagation of a covered +work results from an entity transaction, each party to that +transaction who receives a copy of the work also receives whatever +licenses to the work the party's predecessor in interest had or could +give under the previous paragraph, plus a right to possession of the +Corresponding Source of the work from the predecessor in interest, if +the predecessor has it or can get it with reasonable efforts. + + You may not impose any further restrictions on the exercise of the +rights granted or affirmed under this License. For example, you may +not impose a license fee, royalty, or other charge for exercise of +rights granted under this License, and you may not initiate litigation +(including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that +any patent claim is infringed by making, using, selling, offering for +sale, or importing the Program or any portion of it. + + 11. Patents. + + A "contributor" is a copyright holder who authorizes use under this +License of the Program or a work on which the Program is based. The +work thus licensed is called the contributor's "contributor version". + + A contributor's "essential patent claims" are all patent claims +owned or controlled by the contributor, whether already acquired or +hereafter acquired, that would be infringed by some manner, permitted +by this License, of making, using, or selling its contributor version, +but do not include claims that would be infringed only as a +consequence of further modification of the contributor version. For +purposes of this definition, "control" includes the right to grant +patent sublicenses in a manner consistent with the requirements of +this License. + + Each contributor grants you a non-exclusive, worldwide, royalty-free +patent license under the contributor's essential patent claims, to +make, use, sell, offer for sale, import and otherwise run, modify and +propagate the contents of its contributor version. + + In the following three paragraphs, a "patent license" is any express +agreement or commitment, however denominated, not to enforce a patent +(such as an express permission to practice a patent or covenant not to +sue for patent infringement). To "grant" such a patent license to a +party means to make such an agreement or commitment not to enforce a +patent against the party. + + If you convey a covered work, knowingly relying on a patent license, +and the Corresponding Source of the work is not available for anyone +to copy, free of charge and under the terms of this License, through a +publicly available network server or other readily accessible means, +then you must either (1) cause the Corresponding Source to be so +available, or (2) arrange to deprive yourself of the benefit of the +patent license for this particular work, or (3) arrange, in a manner +consistent with the requirements of this License, to extend the patent +license to downstream recipients. "Knowingly relying" means you have +actual knowledge that, but for the patent license, your conveying the +covered work in a country, or your recipient's use of the covered work +in a country, would infringe one or more identifiable patents in that +country that you have reason to believe are valid. + + If, pursuant to or in connection with a single transaction or +arrangement, you convey, or propagate by procuring conveyance of, a +covered work, and grant a patent license to some of the parties +receiving the covered work authorizing them to use, propagate, modify +or convey a specific copy of the covered work, then the patent license +you grant is automatically extended to all recipients of the covered +work and works based on it. + + A patent license is "discriminatory" if it does not include within +the scope of its coverage, prohibits the exercise of, or is +conditioned on the non-exercise of one or more of the rights that are +specifically granted under this License. You may not convey a covered +work if you are a party to an arrangement with a third party that is +in the business of distributing software, under which you make payment +to the third party based on the extent of your activity of conveying +the work, and under which the third party grants, to any of the +parties who would receive the covered work from you, a discriminatory +patent license (a) in connection with copies of the covered work +conveyed by you (or copies made from those copies), or (b) primarily +for and in connection with specific products or compilations that +contain the covered work, unless you entered into that arrangement, +or that patent license was granted, prior to 28 March 2007. + + Nothing in this License shall be construed as excluding or limiting +any implied license or other defenses to infringement that may +otherwise be available to you under applicable patent law. + + 12. No Surrender of Others' Freedom. + + If conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or +otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not +excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot convey a +covered work so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this +License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may +not convey it at all. For example, if you agree to terms that obligate you +to collect a royalty for further conveying from those to whom you convey +the Program, the only way you could satisfy both those terms and this +License would be to refrain entirely from conveying the Program. + + 13. Use with the GNU Affero General Public License. + + Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, you have +permission to link or combine any covered work with a work licensed +under version 3 of the GNU Affero General Public License into a single +combined work, and to convey the resulting work. The terms of this +License will continue to apply to the part which is the covered work, +but the special requirements of the GNU Affero General Public License, +section 13, concerning interaction through a network will apply to the +combination as such. + + 14. Revised Versions of this License. + + The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of +the GNU General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will +be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to +address new problems or concerns. + + Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the +Program specifies that a certain numbered version of the GNU General +Public License "or any later version" applies to it, you have the +option of following the terms and conditions either of that numbered +version or of any later version published by the Free Software +Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of the +GNU General Public License, you may choose any version ever published +by the Free Software Foundation. + + If the Program specifies that a proxy can decide which future +versions of the GNU General Public License can be used, that proxy's +public statement of acceptance of a version permanently authorizes you +to choose that version for the Program. + + Later license versions may give you additional or different +permissions. However, no additional obligations are imposed on any +author or copyright holder as a result of your choosing to follow a +later version. + + 15. Disclaimer of Warranty. + + THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY +APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT +HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY +OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, +THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR +PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM +IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF +ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION. + + 16. Limitation of Liability. + + IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING +WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MODIFIES AND/OR CONVEYS +THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY +GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE +USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF +DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD +PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), +EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF +SUCH DAMAGES. + + 17. Interpretation of Sections 15 and 16. + + If the disclaimer of warranty and limitation of liability provided +above cannot be given local legal effect according to their terms, +reviewing courts shall apply local law that most closely approximates +an absolute waiver of all civil liability in connection with the +Program, unless a warranty or assumption of liability accompanies a +copy of the Program in return for a fee. + + END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS + + How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs + + If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest +possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it +free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms. + + To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest +to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively +state the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least +the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found. + + <one line to give the program's name and a brief idea of what it does.> + Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> + + This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify + it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by + the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or + (at your option) any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the + GNU General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License + along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. + +Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail. + + If the program does terminal interaction, make it output a short +notice like this when it starts in an interactive mode: + + <program> Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> + This program comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show w'. + This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it + under certain conditions; type `show c' for details. + +The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should show the appropriate +parts of the General Public License. Of course, your program's commands +might be different; for a GUI interface, you would use an "about box". + + You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or school, +if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the program, if necessary. +For more information on this, and how to apply and follow the GNU GPL, see +<http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. + + The GNU General Public License does not permit incorporating your program +into proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you +may consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with +the library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General +Public License instead of this License. But first, please read +<http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/why-not-lgpl.html>. + + GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE + Version 3, 29 June 2007 + + Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/> + Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies + of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. + + + This version of the GNU Lesser General Public License incorporates +the terms and conditions of version 3 of the GNU General Public +License, supplemented by the additional permissions listed below. + + 0. Additional Definitions. + + As used herein, "this License" refers to version 3 of the GNU Lesser +General Public License, and the "GNU GPL" refers to version 3 of the GNU +General Public License. + + "The Library" refers to a covered work governed by this License, +other than an Application or a Combined Work as defined below. + + An "Application" is any work that makes use of an interface provided +by the Library, but which is not otherwise based on the Library. +Defining a subclass of a class defined by the Library is deemed a mode +of using an interface provided by the Library. + + A "Combined Work" is a work produced by combining or linking an +Application with the Library. The particular version of the Library +with which the Combined Work was made is also called the "Linked +Version". + + The "Minimal Corresponding Source" for a Combined Work means the +Corresponding Source for the Combined Work, excluding any source code +for portions of the Combined Work that, considered in isolation, are +based on the Application, and not on the Linked Version. + + The "Corresponding Application Code" for a Combined Work means the +object code and/or source code for the Application, including any data +and utility programs needed for reproducing the Combined Work from the +Application, but excluding the System Libraries of the Combined Work. + + 1. Exception to Section 3 of the GNU GPL. + + You may convey a covered work under sections 3 and 4 of this License +without being bound by section 3 of the GNU GPL. + + 2. Conveying Modified Versions. + + If you modify a copy of the Library, and, in your modifications, a +facility refers to a function or data to be supplied by an Application +that uses the facility (other than as an argument passed when the +facility is invoked), then you may convey a copy of the modified +version: + + a) under this License, provided that you make a good faith effort to + ensure that, in the event an Application does not supply the + function or data, the facility still operates, and performs + whatever part of its purpose remains meaningful, or + + b) under the GNU GPL, with none of the additional permissions of + this License applicable to that copy. + + 3. Object Code Incorporating Material from Library Header Files. + + The object code form of an Application may incorporate material from +a header file that is part of the Library. You may convey such object +code under terms of your choice, provided that, if the incorporated +material is not limited to numerical parameters, data structure +layouts and accessors, or small macros, inline functions and templates +(ten or fewer lines in length), you do both of the following: + + a) Give prominent notice with each copy of the object code that the + Library is used in it and that the Library and its use are + covered by this License. + + b) Accompany the object code with a copy of the GNU GPL and this license + document. + + 4. Combined Works. + + You may convey a Combined Work under terms of your choice that, +taken together, effectively do not restrict modification of the +portions of the Library contained in the Combined Work and reverse +engineering for debugging such modifications, if you also do each of +the following: + + a) Give prominent notice with each copy of the Combined Work that + the Library is used in it and that the Library and its use are + covered by this License. + + b) Accompany the Combined Work with a copy of the GNU GPL and this license + document. + + c) For a Combined Work that displays copyright notices during + execution, include the copyright notice for the Library among + these notices, as well as a reference directing the user to the + copies of the GNU GPL and this license document. + + d) Do one of the following: + + 0) Convey the Minimal Corresponding Source under the terms of this + License, and the Corresponding Application Code in a form + suitable for, and under terms that permit, the user to + recombine or relink the Application with a modified version of + the Linked Version to produce a modified Combined Work, in the + manner specified by section 6 of the GNU GPL for conveying + Corresponding Source. + + 1) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking with the + Library. A suitable mechanism is one that (a) uses at run time + a copy of the Library already present on the user's computer + system, and (b) will operate properly with a modified version + of the Library that is interface-compatible with the Linked + Version. + + e) Provide Installation Information, but only if you would otherwise + be required to provide such information under section 6 of the + GNU GPL, and only to the extent that such information is + necessary to install and execute a modified version of the + Combined Work produced by recombining or relinking the + Application with a modified version of the Linked Version. (If + you use option 4d0, the Installation Information must accompany + the Minimal Corresponding Source and Corresponding Application + Code. If you use option 4d1, you must provide the Installation + Information in the manner specified by section 6 of the GNU GPL + for conveying Corresponding Source.) + + 5. Combined Libraries. + + You may place library facilities that are a work based on the +Library side by side in a single library together with other library +facilities that are not Applications and are not covered by this +License, and convey such a combined library under terms of your +choice, if you do both of the following: + + a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of the same work based + on the Library, uncombined with any other library facilities, + conveyed under the terms of this License. + + b) Give prominent notice with the combined library that part of it + is a work based on the Library, and explaining where to find the + accompanying uncombined form of the same work. + + 6. Revised Versions of the GNU Lesser General Public License. + + The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions +of the GNU Lesser General Public License from time to time. Such new +versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may +differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. + + Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the +Library as you received it specifies that a certain numbered version +of the GNU Lesser General Public License "or any later version" +applies to it, you have the option of following the terms and +conditions either of that published version or of any later version +published by the Free Software Foundation. If the Library as you +received it does not specify a version number of the GNU Lesser +General Public License, you may choose any version of the GNU Lesser +General Public License ever published by the Free Software Foundation. + + If the Library as you received it specifies that a proxy can decide +whether future versions of the GNU Lesser General Public License shall +apply, that proxy's public statement of acceptance of any version is +permanent authorization for you to choose that version for the +Library. + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/x86/libusb0.sys b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/x86/libusb0.sys Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5322e5b978 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/x86/libusb0.sys diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/x86/libusb0_x86.dll b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/x86/libusb0_x86.dll Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6e475b90ac --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/WindowsDriver/x86/libusb0_x86.dll diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e87f33eb01 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,61 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0"> + <project caption="Bulk Vendor Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.vendor.example.avr8"> + <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.vendor"/> + <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> + <generator value="as5_8"/> + + <device-support value="at90usb1287"/> + <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> + + <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/> + <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/> + </project> + + <project caption="Bulk Vendor Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.vendor.example.xmega"> + <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.vendor"/> + <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/> + <generator value="as5_8"/> + + <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/> + <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/> + + <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/> + <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/> + </project> + + <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.vendor" caption="Bulk Vendor Device Demo (Low Level APIs)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Bulk Vendor Device demo, implementing a basic USB device with vendor-specific endpoints for custom protocol implementations. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs. + </info> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/> + + <info type="keyword" value="Technology"> + <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/> + <keyword value="USB Device"/> + </info> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/> + <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="BulkVendor.txt"/> + <build type="distribute" subtype="directory" value="HostTestApp"/> + <build type="distribute" subtype="directory" value="WindowsDriver"/> + + <build type="c-source" value="BulkVendor.c"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="BulkVendor.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/> + + <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/> + + <require idref="lufa.common"/> + <require idref="lufa.platform"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/> + </module> +</asf> diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7c307b0940 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2397 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Bulk Vendor Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ \ + HostTestApp/ \ + WindowsDriver/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..17fd24ae1e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/BulkVendor/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = BulkVendor +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..070eac4712 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 6 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..553223a2b8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,360 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_IADDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_IADDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_IADDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x204E, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 4, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .CDC1_IAD = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_Association_t), .Type = DTYPE_InterfaceAssociation}, + + .FirstInterfaceIndex = INTERFACE_ID_CDC1_CCI, + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .IADStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC1_CCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC1_CCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC1_Functional_Header = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .CDCSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + }, + + .CDC1_Functional_ACM = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ACM, + + .Capabilities = 0x06, + }, + + .CDC1_Functional_Union = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Union, + + .MasterInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC1_CCI, + .SlaveInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC1_DCI, + }, + + .CDC1_ManagementEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC1_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0xFF + }, + + .CDC1_DCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC1_DCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC1_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC1_RX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .CDC1_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC1_TX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .CDC2_IAD = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_Association_t), .Type = DTYPE_InterfaceAssociation}, + + .FirstInterfaceIndex = INTERFACE_ID_CDC2_CCI, + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .IADStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC2_CCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC2_CCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC2_Functional_Header = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .CDCSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + }, + + .CDC2_Functional_ACM = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ACM, + + .Capabilities = 0x06, + }, + + .CDC2_Functional_Union = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Union, + + .MasterInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC2_CCI, + .SlaveInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC2_DCI, + }, + + .CDC2_ManagementEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC2_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0xFF + }, + + .CDC2_DCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC2_DCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC2_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC2_RX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .CDC2_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC2_TX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Dual CDC Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f54fe9c36d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,135 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the first CDC interface's device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC1_TX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Endpoint address of the first CDC interface's host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define CDC1_RX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /** Endpoint address of the first CDC interface's device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC1_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the second CDC interface's device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC2_TX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 4) + + /** Endpoint address of the second CDC interface's host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define CDC2_RX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 5) + + /** Endpoint address of the second CDC interface's device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC2_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 6) + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoints. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE 8 + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC data IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE 16 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // First CDC Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_Association_t CDC1_IAD; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC1_CCI_Interface; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t CDC1_Functional_Header; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t CDC1_Functional_ACM; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t CDC1_Functional_Union; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC1_ManagementEndpoint; + + // First CDC Data Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC1_DCI_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC1_DataOutEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC1_DataInEndpoint; + + // Second CDC Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_Association_t CDC2_IAD; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC2_CCI_Interface; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t CDC2_Functional_Header; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t CDC2_Functional_ACM; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t CDC2_Functional_Union; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC2_ManagementEndpoint; + + // Second CDC Data Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC2_DCI_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC2_DataOutEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC2_DataInEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_CDC1_CCI = 0, /**< CDC1 CCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_CDC1_DCI = 1, /**< CDC1 DCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_CDC2_CCI = 2, /**< CDC2 CCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_CDC2_DCI = 3, /**< CDC2 DCI interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/DualVirtualSerial.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/DualVirtualSerial.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b94a67dab5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/DualVirtualSerial.c @@ -0,0 +1,299 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the DualVirtualSerial demo. This file contains the main tasks of the demo and + * is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "DualVirtualSerial.h" + +/** Contains the current baud rate and other settings of the first virtual serial port. While this demo does not use + * the physical USART and thus does not use these settings, they must still be retained and returned to the host + * upon request or the host will assume the device is non-functional. + * + * These values are set by the host via a class-specific request, however they are not required to be used accurately. + * It is possible to completely ignore these value or use other settings as the host is completely unaware of the physical + * serial link characteristics and instead sends and receives data in endpoint streams. + */ +static CDC_LineEncoding_t LineEncoding1 = { .BaudRateBPS = 0, + .CharFormat = CDC_LINEENCODING_OneStopBit, + .ParityType = CDC_PARITY_None, + .DataBits = 8 }; + +/** Contains the current baud rate and other settings of the second virtual serial port. While this demo does not use + * the physical USART and thus does not use these settings, they must still be retained and returned to the host + * upon request or the host will assume the device is non-functional. + * + * These values are set by the host via a class-specific request, however they are not required to be used accurately. + * It is possible to completely ignore these value or use other settings as the host is completely unaware of the physical + * serial link characteristics and instead sends and receives data in endpoint streams. + */ +static CDC_LineEncoding_t LineEncoding2 = { .BaudRateBPS = 0, + .CharFormat = CDC_LINEENCODING_OneStopBit, + .ParityType = CDC_PARITY_None, + .DataBits = 8 }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + CDC1_Task(); + CDC2_Task(); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Joystick_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB enumerating */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via + * the status LEDs and stops the USB management and CDC management tasks. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB not ready */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This is fired when the host set the current configuration + * of the USB device after enumeration - the device endpoints are configured and the CDC management tasks are started. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + /* Setup first CDC Interface's Endpoints */ + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC1_TX_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, 1); + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC1_RX_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, 1); + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC1_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, 1); + + /* Setup second CDC Interface's Endpoints */ + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC2_TX_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, 1); + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC2_RX_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, 1); + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC2_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, 1); + + /* Reset line encoding baud rates so that the host knows to send new values */ + LineEncoding1.BaudRateBPS = 0; + LineEncoding2.BaudRateBPS = 0; + + /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to + * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing + * internally. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + /* Determine which interface's Line Coding data is being set from the wIndex parameter */ + void* LineEncodingData = (USB_ControlRequest.wIndex == 0) ? &LineEncoding1 : &LineEncoding2; + + /* Process CDC specific control requests */ + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case CDC_REQ_GetLineEncoding: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Write the line coding data to the control endpoint */ + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(LineEncodingData, sizeof(CDC_LineEncoding_t)); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + + break; + case CDC_REQ_SetLineEncoding: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Read the line coding data in from the host into the global struct */ + Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE(LineEncodingData, sizeof(CDC_LineEncoding_t)); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } + + break; + case CDC_REQ_SetControlLineState: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + } +} + +/** Function to manage CDC data transmission and reception to and from the host for the first CDC interface, which sends joystick + * movements to the host as ASCII strings. + */ +void CDC1_Task(void) +{ + char* ReportString = NULL; + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + static bool ActionSent = false; + + /* Device must be connected and configured for the task to run */ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Determine if a joystick action has occurred */ + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + ReportString = "Joystick Up\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + ReportString = "Joystick Down\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + ReportString = "Joystick Left\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + ReportString = "Joystick Right\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + ReportString = "Joystick Pressed\r\n"; + else + ActionSent = false; + + /* Flag management - Only allow one string to be sent per action */ + if ((ReportString != NULL) && (ActionSent == false) && LineEncoding1.BaudRateBPS) + { + ActionSent = true; + + /* Select the Serial Tx Endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC1_TX_EPADDR); + + /* Write the String to the Endpoint */ + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(ReportString, strlen(ReportString), NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Wait until the endpoint is ready for another packet */ + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + + /* Send an empty packet to ensure that the host does not buffer data sent to it */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } + + /* Select the Serial Rx Endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC1_RX_EPADDR); + + /* Throw away any received data from the host */ + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); +} + +/** Function to manage CDC data transmission and reception to and from the host for the second CDC interface, which echoes back + * all data sent to it from the host. + */ +void CDC2_Task(void) +{ + /* Device must be connected and configured for the task to run */ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Select the Serial Rx Endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC2_RX_EPADDR); + + /* Check to see if any data has been received */ + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + { + /* Create a temp buffer big enough to hold the incoming endpoint packet */ + uint8_t Buffer[Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint()]; + + /* Remember how large the incoming packet is */ + uint16_t DataLength = Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint(); + + /* Read in the incoming packet into the buffer */ + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&Buffer, DataLength, NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + /* Select the Serial Tx Endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC2_TX_EPADDR); + + /* Write the received data to the endpoint */ + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&Buffer, DataLength, NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Wait until the endpoint is ready for the next packet */ + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + + /* Send an empty packet to prevent host buffering */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/DualVirtualSerial.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/DualVirtualSerial.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..56a510b7a0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/DualVirtualSerial.h @@ -0,0 +1,77 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for DualVirtualSerial.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DUAL_VIRTUALSERIAL_H_ +#define _DUAL_VIRTUALSERIAL_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void CDC1_Task(void); + void CDC2_Task(void); + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/DualVirtualSerial.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/DualVirtualSerial.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fb763b7a2a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/DualVirtualSerial.txt @@ -0,0 +1,89 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Dual Communications Device Class (Dual Virtual Serial Port) Device + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Abstract Control Model (ACM)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF CDC Class Standard</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Interface Association Descriptor ECN \n + * USBIF CDC Class Standard</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Dual Communications Device Class demonstration application. + * This gives a simple reference application for implementing + * a compound device with dual CDC functions acting as a pair + * of virtual serial ports. This demo uses Interface Association + * Descriptors to link together the pair of related CDC + * descriptors for each virtual serial port, which may not be + * supported in all OSes - Windows Vista is supported, as is + * XP (although the latter may need a hotfix to function). + * + * Joystick actions are transmitted to the host as strings + * through the first serial port. The device does not respond to + * serial data sent from the host in the first serial port. + * + * The second serial port echoes back data sent from the host. + * + * After running this demo for the first time on a new computer, + * you will need to supply the .INF file located in this demo + * project's directory as the device's driver when running under + * Windows. This will enable Windows to use its inbuilt CDC drivers, + * negating the need for custom drivers for the device. Other + * Operating Systems should automatically use their own inbuilt + * CDC-ACM drivers. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/LUFA DualVirtualSerial.inf b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/LUFA DualVirtualSerial.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1a0e0248af --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/LUFA DualVirtualSerial.inf @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +;************************************************************ +; Windows USB CDC ACM Setup File +; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation +;************************************************************ + +[DefaultInstall] +CopyINF="LUFA DualVirtualSerial.inf" + +[Version] +Signature="$Windows NT$" +Class=Ports +ClassGuid={4D36E978-E325-11CE-BFC1-08002BE10318} +Provider=%MFGNAME% +DriverVer=7/1/2012,10.0.0.0 + +[Manufacturer] +%MFGNAME%=DeviceList, NTx86, NTamd64, NTia64 + +[SourceDisksNames] + +[SourceDisksFiles] + +[DestinationDirs] +DefaultDestDir=12 + +[DriverInstall] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +CopyFiles=FakeModemCopyFileSection +AddReg=DriverInstall.AddReg + +[DriverInstall.Services] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +AddService=usbser, 0x00000002, LowerFilter_Service_Inst + +[DriverInstall.AddReg] +HKR,,EnumPropPages32,,"msports.dll,SerialPortPropPageProvider" + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; Vendor and Product ID Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; When developing your USB device, the VID and PID used in the PC side +; application program and the firmware on the microcontroller must match. +; Modify the below line to use your VID and PID. Use the format as shown below. +; Note: One INF file can be used for multiple devices with different VID and PIDs. +; For each supported device, append ",USB\VID_xxxx&PID_yyyy" to the end of the line. +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[DeviceList] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204E&MI_00, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204E&MI_02 + +[DeviceList.NTx86] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204E&MI_00, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204E&MI_02 + +[DeviceList.NTamd64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204E&MI_00, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204E&MI_02 + +[DeviceList.NTia64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204E&MI_00, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204E&MI_02 + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; String Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +;Modify these strings to customize your device +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[Strings] +MFGNAME="http://www.lufa-lib.org" +DESCRIPTION="LUFA CDC-ACM Virtual Serial Port"
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..133d1b4f82 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Dual Virtual Serial Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.dual_cdc.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.dual_cdc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Dual Virtual Serial Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.dual_cdc.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.dual_cdc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.dual_cdc" caption="Dual Virtual Serial Device Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Dual Virtual Serial (CDC) demo, implementing a pair of virtual serial port interfaces. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="CDC Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="DualVirtualSerial.txt"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="LUFA DualVirtualSerial.inf"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="DualVirtualSerial.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="DualVirtualSerial.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..40dcfe9157 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Dual Virtual Serial Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c91ec4f880 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/DualVirtualSerial/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = DualVirtualSerial +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..636200ec6d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define GENERIC_REPORT_SIZE 8 + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..00eefc7bf7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 2 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2a248075ae --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,238 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the + * USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This + * descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding) + * the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for + * more details on HID report descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t PROGMEM GenericReport[] = +{ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(16, 0xFF00), /* Vendor Page 0 */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x01), /* Vendor Usage 1 */ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x01), /* Vendor Usage 1 */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x02), /* Vendor Usage 2 */ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 0xFF), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x08), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, GENERIC_REPORT_SIZE), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE), + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x03), /* Vendor Usage 3 */ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 0xFF), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x08), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, GENERIC_REPORT_SIZE), + HID_RI_OUTPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE | HID_IOF_NON_VOLATILE), + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0), +}; + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x204F, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .HID_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_GenericHID, + .AlternateSetting = 0x00, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_NonBootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_NonBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID_GenericHID = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(GenericReport) + }, + + .HID_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = GENERIC_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = GENERIC_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .HID_ReportOUTEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = GENERIC_OUT_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = GENERIC_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Generic HID Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + case HID_DTYPE_HID: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID_GenericHID; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + break; + case HID_DTYPE_Report: + Address = &GenericReport; + Size = sizeof(GenericReport); + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..30fc7e1ea0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,99 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Generic HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID_Interface; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID_GenericHID; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID_ReportINEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID_ReportOUTEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_GenericHID = 0, /**< GenericHID interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Generic HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define GENERIC_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Endpoint address of the Generic HID reporting OUT endpoint. */ + #define GENERIC_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /** Size in bytes of the Generic HID reporting endpoint. */ + #define GENERIC_EPSIZE 8 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/GenericHID.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/GenericHID.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..916457a2f4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/GenericHID.c @@ -0,0 +1,253 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the GenericHID demo. This file contains the main tasks of the demo and + * is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "GenericHID.h" + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + HID_Task(); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB enumerating */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via + * the status LEDs and stops the USB management task. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB not ready */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This is fired when the host sets the current configuration + * of the USB device after enumeration, and configures the generic HID device endpoints. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + /* Setup HID Report Endpoints */ + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(GENERIC_IN_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, GENERIC_EPSIZE, 1); + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(GENERIC_OUT_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, GENERIC_EPSIZE, 1); + + /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to + * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing + * internally. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + /* Handle HID Class specific requests */ + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case HID_REQ_GetReport: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + uint8_t GenericData[GENERIC_REPORT_SIZE]; + CreateGenericHIDReport(GenericData); + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Write the report data to the control endpoint */ + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(&GenericData, sizeof(GenericData)); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + + break; + case HID_REQ_SetReport: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + uint8_t GenericData[GENERIC_REPORT_SIZE]; + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Read the report data from the control endpoint */ + Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE(&GenericData, sizeof(GenericData)); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + ProcessGenericHIDReport(GenericData); + } + + break; + } +} + +/** Function to process the last received report from the host. + * + * \param[in] DataArray Pointer to a buffer where the last received report has been stored + */ +void ProcessGenericHIDReport(uint8_t* DataArray) +{ + /* + This is where you need to process reports sent from the host to the device. This + function is called each time the host has sent a new report. DataArray is an array + holding the report sent from the host. + */ + + uint8_t NewLEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS; + + if (DataArray[0]) + NewLEDMask |= LEDS_LED1; + + if (DataArray[1]) + NewLEDMask |= LEDS_LED2; + + if (DataArray[2]) + NewLEDMask |= LEDS_LED3; + + if (DataArray[3]) + NewLEDMask |= LEDS_LED4; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(NewLEDMask); +} + +/** Function to create the next report to send back to the host at the next reporting interval. + * + * \param[out] DataArray Pointer to a buffer where the next report data should be stored + */ +void CreateGenericHIDReport(uint8_t* DataArray) +{ + /* + This is where you need to create reports to be sent to the host from the device. This + function is called each time the host is ready to accept a new report. DataArray is + an array to hold the report to the host. + */ + + uint8_t CurrLEDMask = LEDs_GetLEDs(); + + DataArray[0] = ((CurrLEDMask & LEDS_LED1) ? 1 : 0); + DataArray[1] = ((CurrLEDMask & LEDS_LED2) ? 1 : 0); + DataArray[2] = ((CurrLEDMask & LEDS_LED3) ? 1 : 0); + DataArray[3] = ((CurrLEDMask & LEDS_LED4) ? 1 : 0); +} + +void HID_Task(void) +{ + /* Device must be connected and configured for the task to run */ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(GENERIC_OUT_EPADDR); + + /* Check to see if a packet has been sent from the host */ + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + { + /* Check to see if the packet contains data */ + if (Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed()) + { + /* Create a temporary buffer to hold the read in report from the host */ + uint8_t GenericData[GENERIC_REPORT_SIZE]; + + /* Read Generic Report Data */ + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&GenericData, sizeof(GenericData), NULL); + + /* Process Generic Report Data */ + ProcessGenericHIDReport(GenericData); + } + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(GENERIC_IN_EPADDR); + + /* Check to see if the host is ready to accept another packet */ + if (Endpoint_IsINReady()) + { + /* Create a temporary buffer to hold the report to send to the host */ + uint8_t GenericData[GENERIC_REPORT_SIZE]; + + /* Create Generic Report Data */ + CreateGenericHIDReport(GenericData); + + /* Write Generic Report Data */ + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&GenericData, sizeof(GenericData), NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/GenericHID.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/GenericHID.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4e6100c435 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/GenericHID.h @@ -0,0 +1,81 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for GenericHID.c. + */ + +#ifndef _GENERICHID_H_ +#define _GENERICHID_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void HID_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void); + + void ProcessGenericHIDReport(uint8_t* DataArray); + void CreateGenericHIDReport(uint8_t* DataArray); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/GenericHID.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/GenericHID.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0d780f49d1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/GenericHID.txt @@ -0,0 +1,79 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Generic HID Device + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Generic HID device demonstration application. This gives a simple reference application + * for implementing a generic HID device, using the basic USB HID drivers in all modern + * OSes (i.e. no special drivers required). By default it accepts and sends up to 8 byte reports + * to and from a USB Host, and transmits the last sent report back to the host. + * + * On start-up the system will automatically enumerate and function as a vendor HID device. + * When controlled by a custom HID class application, reports can be sent and received by + * both the standard data endpoint and control request methods defined in the HID specification. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>GENERIC_REPORT_SIZE</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>This token defines the size of the device reports, both sent and received (including report ID byte). The value + * must be an integer ranging from 1 to 255.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/HostTestApp/test_generic_hid.py b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/HostTestApp/test_generic_hid.py new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1e5f430195 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/HostTestApp/test_generic_hid.py @@ -0,0 +1,96 @@ +""" + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +""" + +""" + LUFA Generic HID device demo host test script. This script will send a + continuous stream of generic reports to the device, to show a variable LED + pattern on the target board. Send and received report data is printed to + the terminal. + + Requires the pywinusb library (https://pypi.python.org/pypi/pywinusb/). +""" + +import sys +from time import sleep +import pywinusb.hid as hid + +# Generic HID device VID, PID and report payload length (length is increased +# by one to account for the Report ID byte that must be pre-pended) +device_vid = 0x03EB +device_pid = 0x204F +report_length = 1 + 8 + + +def get_hid_device_handle(): + hid_device_filter = hid.HidDeviceFilter(vendor_id=device_vid, + product_id=device_pid) + + valid_hid_devices = hid_device_filter.get_devices() + + if len(valid_hid_devices) is 0: + return None + else: + return valid_hid_devices[0] + + +def send_led_pattern(device, led1, led2, led3, led4): + # Report data for the demo is the report ID (always zero) followed by the + # LED on/off data + report_data = [0, led1, led2, led3, led4] + + # Zero-extend the array to the length the report should be + report_data.extend([0] * (report_length - len(report_data))) + + # Send the generated report to the device + device.send_output_report(report_data) + + print("Sent LED Pattern: {0}".format(report_data[1:5])) + + +def received_led_pattern(report_data): + print("Received LED Pattern: {0}".format(report_data[1:5])) + + +def main(): + hid_device = get_hid_device_handle() + + if hid_device is None: + print("No valid HID device found.") + sys.exit(1) + + try: + hid_device.open() + + print("Connected to device 0x%04X/0x%04X - %s [%s]" % + (hid_device.vendor_id, hid_device.product_id, + hid_device.product_name, hid_device.vendor_name)) + + # Set up the HID input report handler to receive reports + hid_device.set_raw_data_handler(received_led_pattern) + + p = 0 + while (hid_device.is_plugged()): + # Convert the current pattern index to a bit-mask and send + send_led_pattern(hid_device, + (p >> 3) & 1, + (p >> 2) & 1, + (p >> 1) & 1, + (p >> 0) & 1) + + # Compute next LED pattern in sequence + p = (p + 1) % 16 + + # Delay a bit for visual effect + sleep(.2) + + finally: + hid_device.close() + + +if __name__ == '__main__': + main() diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cf1fb80090 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,63 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Generic HID Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.generic_hid.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.generic_hid"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Generic HID Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.generic_hid.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.generic_hid"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.generic_hid" caption="Generic HID Device Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Generic HID device demo, implementing a device whose LEDs can be controlled via HID messages from the host. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="GenericHID.txt"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="directory" value="HostTestApp"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="GenericHID.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="GenericHID.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ffc0d05905 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2396 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Generic HID Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ \ + HostTestApp/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7cd0aac47a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/GenericHID/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = GenericHID +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..299d2ec852 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 1 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..45949897c7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,240 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the + * USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This + * descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding) + * the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for + * more details on HID report descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t PROGMEM JoystickReport[] = +{ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x01), /* Generic Desktop */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x04), /* Joystick */ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x01), /* Application */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x01), /* Pointer */ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x00), /* Physical */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x30), /* Usage X */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x31), /* Usage Y */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x32), /* Usage Z */ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, -100), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 100), + HID_RI_PHYSICAL_MINIMUM(8, -1), + HID_RI_PHYSICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 1), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x03), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x08), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE), + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0), + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x09), /* Button */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(8, 0x02), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x02), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x06), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_CONSTANT), + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0), +}; + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2043, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .HID_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Joystick, + .AlternateSetting = 0x00, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_NonBootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_NonBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID_JoystickHID = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(JoystickReport) + }, + + .HID_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = JOYSTICK_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = JOYSTICK_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Joystick Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + case DTYPE_HID: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID_JoystickHID; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Report: + Address = &JoystickReport; + Size = sizeof(JoystickReport); + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..30ab1059b0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,99 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Joystick HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID_Interface; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID_JoystickHID; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID_ReportINEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_Joystick = 0, /**< Joystick interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Joystick HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define JOYSTICK_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Size in bytes of the Joystick HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define JOYSTICK_EPSIZE 8 + + /** Descriptor header type value, to indicate a HID class HID descriptor. */ + #define DTYPE_HID 0x21 + + /** Descriptor header type value, to indicate a HID class HID report descriptor. */ + #define DTYPE_Report 0x22 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/Joystick.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/Joystick.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7536d1a5fe --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/Joystick.c @@ -0,0 +1,217 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the Joystick demo. This file contains the main tasks of the demo and + * is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "Joystick.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + HID_Task(); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Joystick_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + Buttons_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB enumerating */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via + * the status LEDs and stops the USB management and joystick reporting tasks. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB not ready */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This is fired when the host set the current configuration + * of the USB device after enumeration - the device endpoints are configured and the joystick reporting task started. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + /* Setup HID Report Endpoint */ + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(JOYSTICK_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, JOYSTICK_EPSIZE, 1); + + /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to + * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing + * internally. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + /* Handle HID Class specific requests */ + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case HID_REQ_GetReport: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + USB_JoystickReport_Data_t JoystickReportData; + + /* Create the next HID report to send to the host */ + GetNextReport(&JoystickReportData); + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Write the report data to the control endpoint */ + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(&JoystickReportData, sizeof(JoystickReportData)); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + + break; + } +} + +/** Fills the given HID report data structure with the next HID report to send to the host. + * + * \param[out] ReportData Pointer to a HID report data structure to be filled + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the new report differs from the last report, \c false otherwise + */ +bool GetNextReport(USB_JoystickReport_Data_t* const ReportData) +{ + static uint8_t PrevJoyStatus = 0; + static uint8_t PrevButtonStatus = 0; + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + uint8_t ButtonStatus_LCL = Buttons_GetStatus(); + bool InputChanged = false; + + /* Clear the report contents */ + memset(ReportData, 0, sizeof(USB_JoystickReport_Data_t)); + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + ReportData->Y = -100; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + ReportData->Y = 100; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + ReportData->X = -100; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + ReportData->X = 100; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + ReportData->Button |= (1 << 1); + + if (ButtonStatus_LCL & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) + ReportData->Button |= (1 << 0); + + /* Check if the new report is different to the previous report */ + InputChanged = (uint8_t)(PrevJoyStatus ^ JoyStatus_LCL) | (uint8_t)(PrevButtonStatus ^ ButtonStatus_LCL); + + /* Save the current joystick status for later comparison */ + PrevJoyStatus = JoyStatus_LCL; + PrevButtonStatus = ButtonStatus_LCL; + + /* Return whether the new report is different to the previous report or not */ + return InputChanged; +} + +/** Function to manage HID report generation and transmission to the host. */ +void HID_Task(void) +{ + /* Device must be connected and configured for the task to run */ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Select the Joystick Report Endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(JOYSTICK_EPADDR); + + /* Check to see if the host is ready for another packet */ + if (Endpoint_IsINReady()) + { + USB_JoystickReport_Data_t JoystickReportData; + + /* Create the next HID report to send to the host */ + GetNextReport(&JoystickReportData); + + /* Write Joystick Report Data */ + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&JoystickReportData, sizeof(JoystickReportData), NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Clear the report data afterwards */ + memset(&JoystickReportData, 0, sizeof(JoystickReportData)); + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/Joystick.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/Joystick.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d5fdcccbd3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/Joystick.h @@ -0,0 +1,91 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Joystick.c. + */ + +#ifndef _JOYSTICK_H_ +#define _JOYSTICK_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the joystick HID report structure, for creating and sending HID reports to the host PC. + * This mirrors the layout described to the host in the HID report descriptor, in Descriptors.c. + */ + typedef struct + { + int8_t X; /**< Current absolute joystick X position, as a signed 8-bit integer */ + int8_t Y; /**< Current absolute joystick Y position, as a signed 8-bit integer */ + int8_t Z; /**< Current absolute joystick Z position, as a signed 8-bit integer */ + uint8_t Button; /**< Bit mask of the currently pressed joystick buttons */ + } USB_JoystickReport_Data_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void HID_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + + bool GetNextReport(USB_JoystickReport_Data_t* const ReportData); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/Joystick.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/Joystick.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b174642f4c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/Joystick.txt @@ -0,0 +1,77 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Joystick Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Joystick demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Keyboard device, for USB Joysticks + * using the standard Keyboard HID profile. + * + * This device will show up as a generic joystick device, with two buttons. + * Pressing the joystick inwards is the first button, and the HWB button + * is the second. + * + * Moving the joystick on the selected board moves the joystick location on + * the host computer. + * + * Currently only single interface joysticks are supported. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d37741bace --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Joystick HID Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.joystick.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.joystick"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Joystick HID Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.joystick.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.joystick"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.joystick" caption="Joystick HID Device Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Joystick HID device demo, implementing a basic USB joystick that can send movement information to the host. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="Joystick.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Joystick.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Joystick.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..45ebd1341a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Joystick Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8a29ff4d0f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Joystick/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = Joystick +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..00eefc7bf7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 2 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d0e5bc4459 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,255 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2010 Denver Gingerich (denver [at] ossguy [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the + * USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This + * descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding) + * the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for + * more details on HID report descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t PROGMEM KeyboardReport[] = +{ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x01), /* Generic Desktop */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x06), /* Keyboard */ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x01), /* Application */ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x07), /* Key Codes */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(8, 0xE0), /* Keyboard Left Control */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(8, 0xE7), /* Keyboard Right GUI */ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x08), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x08), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_CONSTANT), + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x08), /* LEDs */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(8, 0x01), /* Num Lock */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(8, 0x05), /* Kana */ + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x05), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_OUTPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE | HID_IOF_NON_VOLATILE), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x03), + HID_RI_OUTPUT(8, HID_IOF_CONSTANT), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 0x65), + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x07), /* Keyboard */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), /* Reserved (no event indicated) */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(8, 0x65), /* Keyboard Application */ + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x06), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x08), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_ARRAY | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE), + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0), +}; + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2042, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .HID_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard, + .AlternateSetting = 0x00, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_BootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_KeyboardBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID_KeyboardHID = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(KeyboardReport) + }, + + .HID_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = KEYBOARD_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = KEYBOARD_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .HID_ReportOUTEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = KEYBOARD_OUT_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = KEYBOARD_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Keyboard Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + case HID_DTYPE_HID: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID_KeyboardHID; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + break; + case HID_DTYPE_Report: + Address = &KeyboardReport; + Size = sizeof(KeyboardReport); + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f9d26e4823 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,98 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2010 Denver Gingerich (denver [at] ossguy [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Keyboard HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID_Interface; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID_KeyboardHID; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID_ReportINEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID_ReportOUTEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard = 0, /**< Keyboard interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Keyboard HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define KEYBOARD_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Endpoint address of the Keyboard HID reporting OUT endpoint. */ + #define KEYBOARD_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /** Size in bytes of the Keyboard HID reporting IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define KEYBOARD_EPSIZE 8 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/Keyboard.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/Keyboard.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c412991e8b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/Keyboard.c @@ -0,0 +1,383 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2010 Denver Gingerich (denver [at] ossguy [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the Keyboard demo. This file contains the main tasks of the demo and + * is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "Keyboard.h" + +/** Indicates what report mode the host has requested, true for normal HID reporting mode, \c false for special boot + * protocol reporting mode. + */ +static bool UsingReportProtocol = true; + +/** Current Idle period. This is set by the host via a Set Idle HID class request to silence the device's reports + * for either the entire idle duration, or until the report status changes (e.g. the user presses a key). + */ +static uint16_t IdleCount = 500; + +/** Current Idle period remaining. When the IdleCount value is set, this tracks the remaining number of idle + * milliseconds. This is separate to the IdleCount timer and is incremented and compared as the host may request + * the current idle period via a Get Idle HID class request, thus its value must be preserved. + */ +static uint16_t IdleMSRemaining = 0; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + HID_Task(); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Joystick_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + Buttons_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB enumerating */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + /* Default to report protocol on connect */ + UsingReportProtocol = true; +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via + * the status LEDs. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB not ready */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This is fired when the host sets the current configuration + * of the USB device after enumeration, and configures the keyboard device endpoints. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + /* Setup HID Report Endpoints */ + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(KEYBOARD_IN_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, KEYBOARD_EPSIZE, 1); + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(KEYBOARD_OUT_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, KEYBOARD_EPSIZE, 1); + + /* Turn on Start-of-Frame events for tracking HID report period expiry */ + USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(); + + /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to + * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing + * internally. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + /* Handle HID Class specific requests */ + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case HID_REQ_GetReport: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t KeyboardReportData; + + /* Create the next keyboard report for transmission to the host */ + CreateKeyboardReport(&KeyboardReportData); + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Write the report data to the control endpoint */ + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(&KeyboardReportData, sizeof(KeyboardReportData)); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + + break; + case HID_REQ_SetReport: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Wait until the LED report has been sent by the host */ + while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + + /* Read in the LED report from the host */ + uint8_t LEDStatus = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + /* Process the incoming LED report */ + ProcessLEDReport(LEDStatus); + } + + break; + case HID_REQ_GetProtocol: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Write the current protocol flag to the host */ + Endpoint_Write_8(UsingReportProtocol); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + case HID_REQ_SetProtocol: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + /* Set or clear the flag depending on what the host indicates that the current Protocol should be */ + UsingReportProtocol = (USB_ControlRequest.wValue != 0); + } + + break; + case HID_REQ_SetIdle: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + /* Get idle period in MSB, IdleCount must be multiplied by 4 to get number of milliseconds */ + IdleCount = ((USB_ControlRequest.wValue & 0xFF00) >> 6); + } + + break; + case HID_REQ_GetIdle: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Write the current idle duration to the host, must be divided by 4 before sent to host */ + Endpoint_Write_8(IdleCount >> 2); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + } +} + +/** Event handler for the USB device Start Of Frame event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void) +{ + /* One millisecond has elapsed, decrement the idle time remaining counter if it has not already elapsed */ + if (IdleMSRemaining) + IdleMSRemaining--; +} + +/** Fills the given HID report data structure with the next HID report to send to the host. + * + * \param[out] ReportData Pointer to a HID report data structure to be filled + */ +void CreateKeyboardReport(USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t* const ReportData) +{ + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + uint8_t ButtonStatus_LCL = Buttons_GetStatus(); + + uint8_t UsedKeyCodes = 0; + + /* Clear the report contents */ + memset(ReportData, 0, sizeof(USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t)); + + /* Make sent key uppercase by indicating that the left shift key is pressed */ + ReportData->Modifier = HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFIER_LEFTSHIFT; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + ReportData->KeyCode[UsedKeyCodes++] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_A; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + ReportData->KeyCode[UsedKeyCodes++] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_B; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + ReportData->KeyCode[UsedKeyCodes++] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_C; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + ReportData->KeyCode[UsedKeyCodes++] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_D; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + ReportData->KeyCode[UsedKeyCodes++] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_E; + + if (ButtonStatus_LCL & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) + ReportData->KeyCode[UsedKeyCodes++] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F; +} + +/** Processes a received LED report, and updates the board LEDs states to match. + * + * \param[in] LEDReport LED status report from the host + */ +void ProcessLEDReport(const uint8_t LEDReport) +{ + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_LED2; + + if (LEDReport & HID_KEYBOARD_LED_NUMLOCK) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED1; + + if (LEDReport & HID_KEYBOARD_LED_CAPSLOCK) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED3; + + if (LEDReport & HID_KEYBOARD_LED_SCROLLLOCK) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED4; + + /* Set the status LEDs to the current Keyboard LED status */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); +} + +/** Sends the next HID report to the host, via the keyboard data endpoint. */ +void SendNextReport(void) +{ + static USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t PrevKeyboardReportData; + USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t KeyboardReportData; + bool SendReport = false; + + /* Create the next keyboard report for transmission to the host */ + CreateKeyboardReport(&KeyboardReportData); + + /* Check if the idle period is set and has elapsed */ + if (IdleCount && (!(IdleMSRemaining))) + { + /* Reset the idle time remaining counter */ + IdleMSRemaining = IdleCount; + + /* Idle period is set and has elapsed, must send a report to the host */ + SendReport = true; + } + else + { + /* Check to see if the report data has changed - if so a report MUST be sent */ + SendReport = (memcmp(&PrevKeyboardReportData, &KeyboardReportData, sizeof(USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t)) != 0); + } + + /* Select the Keyboard Report Endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(KEYBOARD_IN_EPADDR); + + /* Check if Keyboard Endpoint Ready for Read/Write and if we should send a new report */ + if (Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed() && SendReport) + { + /* Save the current report data for later comparison to check for changes */ + PrevKeyboardReportData = KeyboardReportData; + + /* Write Keyboard Report Data */ + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&KeyboardReportData, sizeof(KeyboardReportData), NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } +} + +/** Reads the next LED status report from the host from the LED data endpoint, if one has been sent. */ +void ReceiveNextReport(void) +{ + /* Select the Keyboard LED Report Endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(KEYBOARD_OUT_EPADDR); + + /* Check if Keyboard LED Endpoint contains a packet */ + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + { + /* Check to see if the packet contains data */ + if (Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed()) + { + /* Read in the LED report from the host */ + uint8_t LEDReport = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + /* Process the read LED report from the host */ + ProcessLEDReport(LEDReport); + } + + /* Handshake the OUT Endpoint - clear endpoint and ready for next report */ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } +} + +/** Function to manage HID report generation and transmission to the host, when in report mode. */ +void HID_Task(void) +{ + /* Device must be connected and configured for the task to run */ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Send the next keypress report to the host */ + SendNextReport(); + + /* Process the LED report sent from the host */ + ReceiveNextReport(); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/Keyboard.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/Keyboard.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5c6bad371c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/Keyboard.h @@ -0,0 +1,85 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2010 Denver Gingerich (denver [at] ossguy [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Keyboard.c. + */ + +#ifndef _KEYBOARD_H_ +#define _KEYBOARD_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void HID_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void); + + void CreateKeyboardReport(USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t* const ReportData); + void ProcessLEDReport(const uint8_t LEDReport); + void SendNextReport(void); + void ReceiveNextReport(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/Keyboard.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/Keyboard.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e945dccfeb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/Keyboard.txt @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Keyboard Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Keyboard demonstration application. This gives a simple reference application + * for implementing a USB Keyboard using the basic USB HID drivers in all modern + * OSes (i.e. no special drivers required). It is boot protocol compatible, and thus + * works under compatible BIOS as if it was a native keyboard (e.g. PS/2). + * + * On start-up the system will automatically enumerate and function as a keyboard + * when the USB connection to a host is present. To use the keyboard example, + * manipulate the joystick to send the letters a, b, c, d and e. See the USB HID + * documentation for more information on sending keyboard event and key presses. Unlike + * other LUFA Keyboard demos, this example shows explicitly how to send multiple key presses + * inside the same report to the host. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4d386f46fa --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Keyboard HID Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.keyboard.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.keyboard"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Keyboard HID Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.keyboard.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.keyboard"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.keyboard" caption="Keyboard HID Device Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Keyboard HID device demo, implementing a basic USB keyboard that can send key press information to the host. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="Keyboard.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Keyboard.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Keyboard.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e397319372 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Keyboard Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dd53f3fa0f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Keyboard/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = Keyboard +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cc828a108d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 3 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7efc6d2eeb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,346 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2010 Denver Gingerich (denver [at] ossguy [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the + * USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This + * descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding) + * the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for + * more details on HID report descriptors. + * + * This descriptor describes the mouse HID interface's report structure. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t PROGMEM MouseReport[] = +{ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x01), /* Generic Desktop */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x02), /* Mouse */ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x01), /* Application */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x01), /* Pointer */ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x00), /* Physical */ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x09), /* Button */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(8, 0x03), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x03), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x05), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_CONSTANT), + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x01), /* Generic Desktop */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x30), /* Usage X */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x31), /* Usage Y */ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, -1), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 1), + HID_RI_PHYSICAL_MINIMUM(8, -1), + HID_RI_PHYSICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 1), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x02), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x08), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_RELATIVE), + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0), + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0), +}; + +/** Same as the MouseReport structure, but defines the keyboard HID interface's report structure. */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t PROGMEM KeyboardReport[] = +{ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x01), /* Generic Desktop */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x06), /* Keyboard */ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x01), /* Application */ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x07), /* Key Codes */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(8, 0xE0), /* Keyboard Left Control */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(8, 0xE7), /* Keyboard Right GUI */ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x08), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x08), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_CONSTANT), + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x08), /* LEDs */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(8, 0x01), /* Num Lock */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(8, 0x05), /* Kana */ + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x05), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_OUTPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE | HID_IOF_NON_VOLATILE), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x03), + HID_RI_OUTPUT(8, HID_IOF_CONSTANT), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 0x65), + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x07), /* Keyboard */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), /* Reserved (no event indicated) */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(8, 0x65), /* Keyboard Application */ + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x06), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x08), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_ARRAY | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE), + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0), +}; + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x204D, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .HID1_KeyboardInterface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard, + .AlternateSetting = 0x00, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_BootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_KeyboardBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID1_KeyboardHID = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(KeyboardReport) + }, + + .HID1_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = KEYBOARD_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = HID_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .HID1_ReportOUTEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = KEYBOARD_OUT_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = HID_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .HID2_MouseInterface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Mouse, + .AlternateSetting = 0x00, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_BootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_MouseBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID2_MouseHID = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(MouseReport) + }, + + .HID2_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MOUSE_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = HID_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Mouse and Keyboard Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + case HID_DTYPE_HID: + switch (wIndex) + { + case (INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard): + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID1_KeyboardHID; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + break; + case (INTERFACE_ID_Mouse): + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID2_MouseHID; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + break; + } + break; + case HID_DTYPE_Report: + switch (wIndex) + { + case INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard: + Address = &KeyboardReport; + Size = sizeof(KeyboardReport); + break; + case INTERFACE_ID_Mouse: + Address = &MouseReport; + Size = sizeof(MouseReport); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f59ac97ec1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,107 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2010 Denver Gingerich (denver [at] ossguy [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Keyboard HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID1_KeyboardInterface; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID1_KeyboardHID; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID1_ReportINEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID1_ReportOUTEndpoint; + + // Mouse HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID2_MouseInterface; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID2_MouseHID; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID2_ReportINEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard = 0, /**< Keyboard interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_Mouse = 1, /**< Mouse interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Keyboard HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define KEYBOARD_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Endpoint address of the Keyboard HID reporting OUT endpoint. */ + #define KEYBOARD_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /** Endpoint address of the Mouse HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define MOUSE_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Size in bytes of each of the HID reporting IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define HID_EPSIZE 8 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0f2719ce77 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.c @@ -0,0 +1,321 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2010 Denver Gingerich (denver [at] ossguy [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the KeyboardMouse demo. This file contains the main tasks of the demo and + * is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "KeyboardMouse.h" + +/** Global structure to hold the current keyboard interface HID report, for transmission to the host */ +static USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t KeyboardReportData; + +/** Global structure to hold the current mouse interface HID report, for transmission to the host */ +static USB_MouseReport_Data_t MouseReportData; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + Keyboard_HID_Task(); + Mouse_HID_Task(); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Joystick_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB enumerating */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via + * the status LEDs and stops the USB management task. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB not ready */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This is fired when the host sets the current configuration + * of the USB device after enumeration, and configures the keyboard and mouse device endpoints. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + /* Setup Keyboard HID Report Endpoints */ + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(KEYBOARD_IN_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, HID_EPSIZE, 1); + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(KEYBOARD_OUT_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, HID_EPSIZE, 1); + + /* Setup Mouse HID Report Endpoint */ + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(MOUSE_IN_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, HID_EPSIZE, 1); + + /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to + * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing + * internally. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + uint8_t* ReportData; + uint8_t ReportSize; + + /* Handle HID Class specific requests */ + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case HID_REQ_GetReport: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Determine if it is the mouse or the keyboard data that is being requested */ + if (!(USB_ControlRequest.wIndex)) + { + ReportData = (uint8_t*)&KeyboardReportData; + ReportSize = sizeof(KeyboardReportData); + } + else + { + ReportData = (uint8_t*)&MouseReportData; + ReportSize = sizeof(MouseReportData); + } + + /* Write the report data to the control endpoint */ + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(ReportData, ReportSize); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + /* Clear the report data afterwards */ + memset(ReportData, 0, ReportSize); + } + + break; + case HID_REQ_SetReport: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Wait until the LED report has been sent by the host */ + while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + + /* Read in the LED report from the host */ + uint8_t LEDStatus = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + /* Process the incoming LED report */ + Keyboard_ProcessLEDReport(LEDStatus); + } + + break; + } +} + +/** Processes a given Keyboard LED report from the host, and sets the board LEDs to match. Since the Keyboard + * LED report can be sent through either the control endpoint (via a HID SetReport request) or the HID OUT + * endpoint, the processing code is placed here to avoid duplicating it and potentially having different + * behavior depending on the method used to sent it. + */ +void Keyboard_ProcessLEDReport(const uint8_t LEDStatus) +{ + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_LED2; + + if (LEDStatus & HID_KEYBOARD_LED_NUMLOCK) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED1; + + if (LEDStatus & HID_KEYBOARD_LED_CAPSLOCK) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED3; + + if (LEDStatus & HID_KEYBOARD_LED_SCROLLLOCK) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED4; + + /* Set the status LEDs to the current Keyboard LED status */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); +} + +/** Keyboard task. This generates the next keyboard HID report for the host, and transmits it via the + * keyboard IN endpoint when the host is ready for more data. Additionally, it processes host LED status + * reports sent to the device via the keyboard OUT reporting endpoint. + */ +void Keyboard_HID_Task(void) +{ + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + + /* Device must be connected and configured for the task to run */ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Check if board button is not pressed, if so mouse mode enabled */ + if (!(Buttons_GetStatus() & BUTTONS_BUTTON1)) + { + /* Make sent key uppercase by indicating that the left shift key is pressed */ + KeyboardReportData.Modifier = HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFIER_LEFTSHIFT; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + KeyboardReportData.KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_A; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + KeyboardReportData.KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_B; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + KeyboardReportData.KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_C; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + KeyboardReportData.KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_D; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + KeyboardReportData.KeyCode[0] = HID_KEYBOARD_SC_E; + } + + /* Select the Keyboard Report Endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(KEYBOARD_IN_EPADDR); + + /* Check if Keyboard Endpoint Ready for Read/Write */ + if (Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed()) + { + /* Write Keyboard Report Data */ + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&KeyboardReportData, sizeof(KeyboardReportData), NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Clear the report data afterwards */ + memset(&KeyboardReportData, 0, sizeof(KeyboardReportData)); + } + + /* Select the Keyboard LED Report Endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(KEYBOARD_OUT_EPADDR); + + /* Check if Keyboard LED Endpoint Ready for Read/Write */ + if (Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed()) + { + /* Read in and process the LED report from the host */ + Keyboard_ProcessLEDReport(Endpoint_Read_8()); + + /* Handshake the OUT Endpoint - clear endpoint and ready for next report */ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } +} + +/** Mouse task. This generates the next mouse HID report for the host, and transmits it via the + * mouse IN endpoint when the host is ready for more data. + */ +void Mouse_HID_Task(void) +{ + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + + /* Device must be connected and configured for the task to run */ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Check if board button is pressed, if so mouse mode enabled */ + if (Buttons_GetStatus() & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) + { + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + MouseReportData.Y = 1; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + MouseReportData.Y = -1; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + MouseReportData.X = 1; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + MouseReportData.X = -1; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + MouseReportData.Button |= (1 << 0); + } + + /* Select the Mouse Report Endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MOUSE_IN_EPADDR); + + /* Check if Mouse Endpoint Ready for Read/Write */ + if (Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed()) + { + /* Write Mouse Report Data */ + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&MouseReportData, sizeof(MouseReportData), NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Clear the report data afterwards */ + memset(&MouseReportData, 0, sizeof(MouseReportData)); + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4bcb33c06c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.h @@ -0,0 +1,77 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2010 Denver Gingerich (denver [at] ossguy [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#ifndef _KEYBOARD_MOUSE_H_ +#define _KEYBOARD_MOUSE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void Keyboard_ProcessLEDReport(const uint8_t LEDStatus); + void Keyboard_HID_Task(void); + void Mouse_HID_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..262a84f0ed --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.txt @@ -0,0 +1,81 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Dual HID Keyboard and Mouse Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Keyboard/Mouse demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a composite device containing both USB Keyboard + * and USB Mouse functionality using the basic USB HID drivers in all modern OSes + * (i.e. no special drivers required). This example uses two separate HID + * interfaces for each function. It is boot protocol compatible, and thus works under + * compatible BIOS as if it was a native keyboard and mouse (e.g. PS/2). + * + * On start-up the system will automatically enumerate and function + * as a keyboard when the USB connection to a host is present and the HWB is not + * pressed. When enabled, manipulate the joystick to send the letters + * a, b, c, d and e. See the USB HID documentation for more information + * on sending keyboard event and key presses. + * + * When the HWB is pressed, the mouse mode is enabled. When enabled, move the + * joystick to move the pointer, and push the joystick inwards to simulate a + * left-button click. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d44bb8043a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Keyboard and Mouse HID Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.keyboard_mouse.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.keyboard_mouse"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Keyboard and Mouse HID Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.keyboard_mouse.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.keyboard_mouse"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.keyboard_mouse" caption="Keyboard and Mouse HID Device Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Keyboard and Mouse HID device demo, implementing a basic USB keyboard and mouse using a pair of HID interfaces. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="KeyboardMouse.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="KeyboardMouse.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="KeyboardMouse.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6648a78d11 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Combined Keyboard/Mouse Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cff064f9ac --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/KeyboardMouse/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = KeyboardMouse +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..00eefc7bf7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 2 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b4bcea1ee7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,314 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2048, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .Audio_ControlInterface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioControl, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 0, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_ControlSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_ControlProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_ControlInterface_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .ACSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,0,0), + .TotalLength = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t), + + .InCollection = 1, + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_MIDIStreamingSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_StreamingProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_AudioInterface_AS_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_General, + + .AudioSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,0,0), + + .TotalLength = (sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t) - + offsetof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t, Audio_StreamInterface_SPC)) + }, + + .MIDI_In_Jack_Emb = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_InputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_Embedded, + .JackID = 0x01, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_In_Jack_Ext = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_InputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_External, + .JackID = 0x02, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_Out_Jack_Emb = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_OutputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_Embedded, + .JackID = 0x03, + + .NumberOfPins = 1, + .SourceJackID = {0x02}, + .SourcePinID = {0x01}, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_Out_Jack_Ext = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_OutputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_External, + .JackID = 0x04, + + .NumberOfPins = 1, + .SourceJackID = {0x01}, + .SourcePinID = {0x01}, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_In_Jack_Endpoint = + { + .Endpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MIDI_STREAM_OUT_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .Refresh = 0, + .SyncEndpointNumber = 0 + }, + + .MIDI_In_Jack_Endpoint_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_Jack_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSEndpoint}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSEndpoint_General, + + .TotalEmbeddedJacks = 0x01, + .AssociatedJackID = {0x01} + }, + + .MIDI_Out_Jack_Endpoint = + { + .Endpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MIDI_STREAM_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .Refresh = 0, + .SyncEndpointNumber = 0 + }, + + .MIDI_Out_Jack_Endpoint_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_Jack_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSEndpoint}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSEndpoint_General, + + .TotalEmbeddedJacks = 0x01, + .AssociatedJackID = {0x03} + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA MIDI Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a477d9dc82 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,108 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the MIDI streaming data IN endpoint, for device-to-host data transfers. */ + #define MIDI_STREAM_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Endpoint address of the MIDI streaming data OUT endpoint, for host-to-device data transfers. */ + #define MIDI_STREAM_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /** Endpoint size in bytes of the Audio isochronous streaming data IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE 64 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // MIDI Audio Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_ControlInterface; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t Audio_ControlInterface_SPC; + + // MIDI Audio Streaming Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_StreamInterface; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_AudioInterface_AS_t Audio_StreamInterface_SPC; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t MIDI_In_Jack_Emb; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t MIDI_In_Jack_Ext; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t MIDI_Out_Jack_Emb; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t MIDI_Out_Jack_Ext; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t MIDI_In_Jack_Endpoint; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_Jack_Endpoint_t MIDI_In_Jack_Endpoint_SPC; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t MIDI_Out_Jack_Endpoint; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_Jack_Endpoint_t MIDI_Out_Jack_Endpoint_SPC; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_AudioControl = 0, /**< Audio control interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream = 1, /**< Audio stream interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/MIDI.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/MIDI.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0fdb04597c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/MIDI.c @@ -0,0 +1,224 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the MIDI input demo. This file contains the main tasks of the demo and + * is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "MIDI.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + MIDI_Task(); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Joystick_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + Buttons_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB enumerating */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via + * the status LEDs, disables the sample update and PWM output timers and stops the USB and MIDI management tasks. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB not ready */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This is fired when the host set the current configuration + * of the USB device after enumeration - the device endpoints are configured and the MIDI management task started. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + /* Setup MIDI Data Endpoints */ + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(MIDI_STREAM_IN_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE, 1); + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(MIDI_STREAM_OUT_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE, 1); + + /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Task to handle the generation of MIDI note change events in response to presses of the board joystick, and send them + * to the host. + */ +void MIDI_Task(void) +{ + static uint8_t PrevJoystickStatus; + + /* Device must be connected and configured for the task to run */ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MIDI_STREAM_IN_EPADDR); + + if (Endpoint_IsINReady()) + { + uint8_t MIDICommand = 0; + uint8_t MIDIPitch; + + uint8_t JoystickStatus = Joystick_GetStatus(); + uint8_t JoystickChanges = (JoystickStatus ^ PrevJoystickStatus); + + /* Get board button status - if pressed use channel 10 (percussion), otherwise use channel 1 */ + uint8_t Channel = ((Buttons_GetStatus() & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ? MIDI_CHANNEL(10) : MIDI_CHANNEL(1)); + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_LEFT) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_LEFT)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3C; + } + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_UP) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_UP)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3D; + } + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_RIGHT) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_RIGHT)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3E; + } + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_DOWN) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_DOWN)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3F; + } + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_PRESS) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_PRESS)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3B; + } + + /* Check if a MIDI command is to be sent */ + if (MIDICommand) + { + MIDI_EventPacket_t MIDIEvent = (MIDI_EventPacket_t) + { + .Event = MIDI_EVENT(0, MIDICommand), + + .Data1 = MIDICommand | Channel, + .Data2 = MIDIPitch, + .Data3 = MIDI_STANDARD_VELOCITY, + }; + + /* Write the MIDI event packet to the endpoint */ + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&MIDIEvent, sizeof(MIDIEvent), NULL); + + /* Send the data in the endpoint to the host */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } + + /* Save previous joystick value for next joystick change detection */ + PrevJoystickStatus = JoystickStatus; + } + + /* Select the MIDI OUT stream */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MIDI_STREAM_OUT_EPADDR); + + /* Check if a MIDI command has been received */ + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + { + MIDI_EventPacket_t MIDIEvent; + + /* Read the MIDI event packet from the endpoint */ + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&MIDIEvent, sizeof(MIDIEvent), NULL); + + /* Check to see if the sent command is a note on message with a non-zero velocity */ + if ((MIDIEvent.Event == MIDI_EVENT(0, MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON)) && (MIDIEvent.Data3 > 0)) + { + /* Change LEDs depending on the pitch of the sent note */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(MIDIEvent.Data2 > 64 ? LEDS_LED1 : LEDS_LED2); + } + else + { + /* Turn off all LEDs in response to non Note On messages */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDS_NO_LEDS); + } + + /* If the endpoint is now empty, clear the bank */ + if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint())) + { + /* Clear the endpoint ready for new packet */ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/MIDI.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/MIDI.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..55ba499b50 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/MIDI.h @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for AudioOutput.c. + */ + +#ifndef _AUDIO_OUTPUT_H_ +#define _AUDIO_OUTPUT_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void MIDI_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/MIDI.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/MIDI.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..97a92a1907 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/MIDI.txt @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage MIDI Input Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Audio Class</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Standard Audio Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Audio Class Specification \n + * USB-MIDI Audio Class Extension Specification \n + * General MIDI Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * MIDI demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing the USB-MIDI class in USB devices. + * It is built upon the USB Audio class. + * + * Joystick movements are translated into note on/off messages and + * are sent to the host PC as MIDI streams which can be read by any + * MIDI program supporting MIDI IN devices. + * + * If the HWB is not pressed, channel 1 (default piano) is used. If + * the HWB is pressed, then channel 10 (default percussion) is selected. + * + * This device implements MIDI-THRU mode, with the IN MIDI data being + * generated by the device itself. OUT MIDI data is discarded. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..477b7d749e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="MIDI Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.midi.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.midi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="MIDI Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.midi.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.midi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.midi" caption="MIDI Device Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ MIDI device demo, implementing a basic USB MIDI device that can send messages to the host. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="MIDI Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="MIDI.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="MIDI.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="MIDI.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e7bfea0c02 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - MIDI Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5f98afa2ac --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MIDI/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = MIDI +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b18b2c4149 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define TOTAL_LUNS 1 + + #define DISK_READ_ONLY false + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0ec4635eb0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 4 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..115a7482c4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,194 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2045, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED, + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .MS_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = MS_CSCP_MassStorageClass, + .SubClass = MS_CSCP_SCSITransparentSubclass, + .Protocol = MS_CSCP_BulkOnlyTransportProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MS_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .MS_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Mass Storage Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c8614c942d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,98 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Mass Storage device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the Mass Storage host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) + + /** Size in bytes of the Mass Storage data endpoints. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE 64 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Mass Storage Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t MS_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t MS_DataInEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t MS_DataOutEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage = 0, /**< Mass storage interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Lib/DataflashManager.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Lib/DataflashManager.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ebd1b39c3f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Lib/DataflashManager.c @@ -0,0 +1,530 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Functions to manage the physical Dataflash media, including reading and writing of + * blocks of data. These functions are called by the SCSI layer when data must be stored + * or retrieved to/from the physical storage media. If a different media is used (such + * as a SD card or EEPROM), functions similar to these will need to be generated. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_DATAFLASHMANAGER_C +#include "DataflashManager.h" + +/** Writes blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) to the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), from + * the pre-selected data OUT endpoint. This routine reads in OS sized blocks from the endpoint and writes + * them to the Dataflash in Dataflash page sized blocks. + * + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the write sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to write + */ +void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + bool UsingSecondBuffer = false; + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, CurrDFPageByte); + + /* Wait until endpoint is ready before continuing */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Write an endpoint packet sized data block to the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if the endpoint is currently empty */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + /* Clear the current endpoint bank */ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + /* Wait until the host has sent another packet */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + } + + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Once all the Dataflash ICs have had their first buffers filled, switch buffers to maintain throughput */ + if (Dataflash_GetSelectedChip() == DATAFLASH_CHIP_MASK(DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS)) + UsingSecondBuffer = !(UsingSecondBuffer); + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* If less than one Dataflash page remaining, copy over the existing page to preserve trailing data */ + if ((TotalBlocks * (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) < (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF2 : DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + } +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2WRITE : DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, 0); + } + + /* Write one 16-byte chunk of data to the Dataflash */ + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + + /* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ + if (IsMassStoreReset) + return; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0x00); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + + /* If the endpoint is empty, clear it ready for the next packet from the host */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Reads blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) from the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), into + * the pre-selected data IN endpoint. This routine reads in Dataflash page sized blocks from the Dataflash + * and writes them in OS sized blocks to the endpoint. + * + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the read sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to read + */ +void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, CurrDFPageByte); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + + /* Wait until endpoint is ready before continuing */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Read an endpoint packet sized data block from the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if the endpoint is currently full */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + /* Clear the endpoint bank to send its contents to the host */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Wait until the endpoint is ready for more data */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + } + + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + } + + /* Read one 16-byte chunk of data from the Dataflash */ + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + + /* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ + if (IsMassStoreReset) + return; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* If the endpoint is full, send its contents to the host */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Writes blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) to the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), from + * the given RAM buffer. This routine reads in OS sized blocks from the buffer and writes them to the + * Dataflash in Dataflash page sized blocks. This can be linked to FAT libraries to write files to the + * Dataflash. + * + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the write sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to write + * \param[in] BufferPtr Pointer to the data source RAM buffer + */ +void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + bool UsingSecondBuffer = false; + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, CurrDFPageByte); + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Write an endpoint packet sized data block to the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Once all the Dataflash ICs have had their first buffers filled, switch buffers to maintain throughput */ + if (Dataflash_GetSelectedChip() == DATAFLASH_CHIP_MASK(DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS)) + UsingSecondBuffer = !(UsingSecondBuffer); + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* If less than one Dataflash page remaining, copy over the existing page to preserve trailing data */ + if ((TotalBlocks * (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) < (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF2 : DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + } +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2WRITE : DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, 0); + } + + /* Write one 16-byte chunk of data to the Dataflash */ + for (uint8_t ByteNum = 0; ByteNum < 16; ByteNum++) + Dataflash_SendByte(*(BufferPtr++)); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0x00); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Reads blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) from the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), into + * the preallocated RAM buffer. This routine reads in Dataflash page sized blocks from the Dataflash + * and writes them in OS sized blocks to the given buffer. This can be linked to FAT libraries to read + * the files stored on the Dataflash. + * + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the read sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to read + * \param[out] BufferPtr Pointer to the data destination RAM buffer + */ +void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, CurrDFPageByte); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Read an endpoint packet sized data block from the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + } + + /* Read one 16-byte chunk of data from the Dataflash */ + for (uint8_t ByteNum = 0; ByteNum < 16; ByteNum++) + *(BufferPtr++) = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Disables the Dataflash memory write protection bits on the board Dataflash ICs, if enabled. */ +void DataflashManager_ResetDataflashProtections(void) +{ + /* Select first Dataflash chip, send the read status register command */ + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + + /* Check if sector protection is enabled */ + if (Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_SECTORPROTECTION_ON) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + + /* Send the commands to disable sector protection */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[0]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[1]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[2]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[3]); + } + + /* Select second Dataflash chip (if present on selected board), send read status register command */ + #if (DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS == 2) + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP2); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + + /* Check if sector protection is enabled */ + if (Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_SECTORPROTECTION_ON) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + + /* Send the commands to disable sector protection */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[0]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[1]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[2]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[3]); + } + #endif + + /* Deselect current Dataflash chip */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Performs a simple test on the attached Dataflash IC(s) to ensure that they are working. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if all media chips are working, \c false otherwise + */ +bool DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation(void) +{ + uint8_t ReturnByte; + + /* Test first Dataflash IC is present and responding to commands */ + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_READMANUFACTURERDEVICEINFO); + ReturnByte = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + /* If returned data is invalid, fail the command */ + if (ReturnByte != DF_MANUFACTURER_ATMEL) + return false; + + #if (DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS == 2) + /* Test second Dataflash IC is present and responding to commands */ + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP2); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_READMANUFACTURERDEVICEINFO); + ReturnByte = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + /* If returned data is invalid, fail the command */ + if (ReturnByte != DF_MANUFACTURER_ATMEL) + return false; + #endif + + return true; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Lib/DataflashManager.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Lib/DataflashManager.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bfb7b55c5b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Lib/DataflashManager.h @@ -0,0 +1,86 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for DataflashManager.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DATAFLASH_MANAGER_H_ +#define _DATAFLASH_MANAGER_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + + #include "../MassStorage.h" + #include "../Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h> + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE % 16) + #error Dataflash page size must be a multiple of 16 bytes. + #endif + + /* Defines: */ + /** Total number of bytes of the storage medium, comprised of one or more Dataflash ICs. */ + #define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES ((uint32_t)DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) + + /** Block size of the device. This is kept at 512 to remain compatible with the OS despite the underlying + * storage media (Dataflash) using a different native block size. Do not change this value. + */ + #define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE 512 + + /** Total number of blocks of the virtual memory for reporting to the host as the device's total capacity. Do not + * change this value; change VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES instead to alter the media size. + */ + #define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCKS (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES / VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + + /** Blocks in each LUN, calculated from the total capacity divided by the total number of Logical Units in the device. */ + #define LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCKS / TOTAL_LUNS) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks); + void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks); + void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + void DataflashManager_ResetDataflashProtections(void); + bool DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bb5775ca66 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.c @@ -0,0 +1,344 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * SCSI command processing routines, for SCSI commands issued by the host. Mass Storage + * devices use a thin "Bulk-Only Transport" protocol for issuing commands and status information, + * which wrap around standard SCSI device commands for controlling the actual storage medium. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_SCSI_C +#include "SCSI.h" + +/** Structure to hold the SCSI response data to a SCSI INQUIRY command. This gives information about the device's + * features and capabilities. + */ +static const SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t InquiryData = + { + .DeviceType = DEVICE_TYPE_BLOCK, + .PeripheralQualifier = 0, + + .Removable = true, + + .Version = 0, + + .ResponseDataFormat = 2, + .NormACA = false, + .TrmTsk = false, + .AERC = false, + + .AdditionalLength = 0x1F, + + .SoftReset = false, + .CmdQue = false, + .Linked = false, + .Sync = false, + .WideBus16Bit = false, + .WideBus32Bit = false, + .RelAddr = false, + + .VendorID = "LUFA", + .ProductID = "Dataflash Disk", + .RevisionID = {'0','.','0','0'}, + }; + +/** Structure to hold the sense data for the last issued SCSI command, which is returned to the host after a SCSI REQUEST SENSE + * command is issued. This gives information on exactly why the last command failed to complete. + */ +static SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t SenseData = + { + .ResponseCode = 0x70, + .AdditionalLength = 0x0A, + }; + + +/** Main routine to process the SCSI command located in the Command Block Wrapper read from the host. This dispatches + * to the appropriate SCSI command handling routine if the issued command is supported by the device, else it returns + * a command failure due to a ILLEGAL REQUEST. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise + */ +bool SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(void) +{ + bool CommandSuccess = false; + + /* Run the appropriate SCSI command hander function based on the passed command */ + switch (CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[0]) + { + case SCSI_CMD_INQUIRY: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Inquiry(); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_REQUEST_SENSE: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_READ_CAPACITY_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_SEND_DIAGNOSTIC: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_WRITE_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(DATA_WRITE); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_READ_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(DATA_READ); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_MODE_SENSE_6: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_START_STOP_UNIT: + case SCSI_CMD_TEST_UNIT_READY: + case SCSI_CMD_PREVENT_ALLOW_MEDIUM_REMOVAL: + case SCSI_CMD_VERIFY_10: + /* These commands should just succeed, no handling required */ + CommandSuccess = true; + CommandBlock.DataTransferLength = 0; + break; + default: + /* Update the SENSE key to reflect the invalid command */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_COMMAND, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + break; + } + + /* Check if command was successfully processed */ + if (CommandSuccess) + { + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_GOOD, + SCSI_ASENSE_NO_ADDITIONAL_INFORMATION, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return true; + } + + return false; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI INQUIRY command. This command returns information about the device's features + * and capabilities to the host. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Inquiry(void) +{ + uint16_t AllocationLength = SwapEndian_16(*(uint16_t*)&CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[3]); + uint16_t BytesTransferred = MIN(AllocationLength, sizeof(InquiryData)); + + /* Only the standard INQUIRY data is supported, check if any optional INQUIRY bits set */ + if ((CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[1] & ((1 << 0) | (1 << 1))) || + CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[2]) + { + /* Optional but unsupported bits set - update the SENSE key and fail the request */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_FIELD_IN_CDB, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Write the INQUIRY data to the endpoint */ + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&InquiryData, BytesTransferred, NULL); + + /* Pad out remaining bytes with 0x00 */ + Endpoint_Null_Stream((AllocationLength - BytesTransferred), NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= BytesTransferred; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI REQUEST SENSE command. This command returns information about the last issued command, + * including the error code and additional error information so that the host can determine why a command failed to complete. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(void) +{ + uint8_t AllocationLength = CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[4]; + uint8_t BytesTransferred = MIN(AllocationLength, sizeof(SenseData)); + + /* Send the SENSE data - this indicates to the host the status of the last command */ + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&SenseData, BytesTransferred, NULL); + + /* Pad out remaining bytes with 0x00 */ + Endpoint_Null_Stream((AllocationLength - BytesTransferred), NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= BytesTransferred; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI READ CAPACITY (10) command. This command returns information about the device's capacity + * on the selected Logical Unit (drive), as a number of OS-sized blocks. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(void) +{ + /* Send the total number of logical blocks in the current LUN */ + Endpoint_Write_32_BE(LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS - 1); + + /* Send the logical block size of the device (must be 512 bytes) */ + Endpoint_Write_32_BE(VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE); + + /* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ + if (IsMassStoreReset) + return false; + + /* Send the endpoint data packet to the host */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= 8; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI SEND DIAGNOSTIC command. This command performs a quick check of the Dataflash ICs on the + * board, and indicates if they are present and functioning correctly. Only the Self-Test portion of the diagnostic command is + * supported. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(void) +{ + /* Check to see if the SELF TEST bit is not set */ + if (!(CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[1] & (1 << 2))) + { + /* Only self-test supported - update SENSE key and fail the command */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_FIELD_IN_CDB, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Check to see if all attached Dataflash ICs are functional */ + if (!(DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation())) + { + /* Update SENSE key with a hardware error condition and return command fail */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_HARDWARE_ERROR, + SCSI_ASENSE_NO_ADDITIONAL_INFORMATION, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + CommandBlock.DataTransferLength = 0; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI READ (10) or WRITE (10) command. This command reads in the block start address + * and total number of blocks to process, then calls the appropriate low-level Dataflash routine to handle the actual + * reading and writing of the data. + * + * \param[in] IsDataRead Indicates if the command is a READ (10) command or WRITE (10) command (DATA_READ or DATA_WRITE) + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(const bool IsDataRead) +{ + uint32_t BlockAddress; + uint16_t TotalBlocks; + + /* Check if the disk is write protected or not */ + if ((IsDataRead == DATA_WRITE) && DISK_READ_ONLY) + { + /* Block address is invalid, update SENSE key and return command fail */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_DATA_PROTECT, + SCSI_ASENSE_WRITE_PROTECTED, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + BlockAddress = SwapEndian_32(*(uint32_t*)&CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[2]); + TotalBlocks = SwapEndian_16(*(uint16_t*)&CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[7]); + + /* Check if the block address is outside the maximum allowable value for the LUN */ + if (BlockAddress >= LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS) + { + /* Block address is invalid, update SENSE key and return command fail */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_LOGICAL_BLOCK_ADDRESS_OUT_OF_RANGE, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + #if (TOTAL_LUNS > 1) + /* Adjust the given block address to the real media address based on the selected LUN */ + BlockAddress += ((uint32_t)CommandBlock.LUN * LUN_MEDIA_BLOCKS); + #endif + + /* Determine if the packet is a READ (10) or WRITE (10) command, call appropriate function */ + if (IsDataRead == DATA_READ) + DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(BlockAddress, TotalBlocks); + else + DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(BlockAddress, TotalBlocks); + + /* Update the bytes transferred counter and succeed the command */ + CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= ((uint32_t)TotalBlocks * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE); + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI MODE SENSE (6) command. This command returns various informational pages about + * the SCSI device, as well as the device's Write Protect status. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(void) +{ + /* Send an empty header response with the Write Protect flag status */ + Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); + Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); + Endpoint_Write_8(DISK_READ_ONLY ? 0x80 : 0x00); + Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Update the bytes transferred counter and succeed the command */ + CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= 4; + + return true; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b1488b492c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/Lib/SCSI.h @@ -0,0 +1,150 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for SCSI.c. + */ + +#ifndef _SCSI_H_ +#define _SCSI_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + + #include "../MassStorage.h" + #include "../Descriptors.h" + #include "DataflashManager.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Macro to set the current SCSI sense data to the given key, additional sense code and additional sense qualifier. This + * is for convenience, as it allows for all three sense values (returned upon request to the host to give information about + * the last command failure) in a quick and easy manner. + * + * \param[in] Key New SCSI sense key to set the sense code to + * \param[in] Acode New SCSI additional sense key to set the additional sense code to + * \param[in] Aqual New SCSI additional sense key qualifier to set the additional sense qualifier code to + */ + #define SCSI_SET_SENSE(Key, Acode, Aqual) do { SenseData.SenseKey = (Key); \ + SenseData.AdditionalSenseCode = (Acode); \ + SenseData.AdditionalSenseQualifier = (Aqual); } while (0) + + /** Macro for the \ref SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10() function, to indicate that data is to be read from the storage medium. */ + #define DATA_READ true + + /** Macro for the \ref SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10() function, to indicate that data is to be written to the storage medium. */ + #define DATA_WRITE false + + /** Value for the DeviceType entry in the SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t enum, indicating a Block Media device. */ + #define DEVICE_TYPE_BLOCK 0x00 + + /** Value for the DeviceType entry in the SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t enum, indicating a CD-ROM device. */ + #define DEVICE_TYPE_CDROM 0x05 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a SCSI response structure to a SCSI INQUIRY command. For details of the + * structure contents, refer to the SCSI specifications. + */ + typedef struct + { + unsigned DeviceType : 5; + unsigned PeripheralQualifier : 3; + + unsigned Reserved : 7; + unsigned Removable : 1; + + uint8_t Version; + + unsigned ResponseDataFormat : 4; + unsigned Reserved2 : 1; + unsigned NormACA : 1; + unsigned TrmTsk : 1; + unsigned AERC : 1; + + uint8_t AdditionalLength; + uint8_t Reserved3[2]; + + unsigned SoftReset : 1; + unsigned CmdQue : 1; + unsigned Reserved4 : 1; + unsigned Linked : 1; + unsigned Sync : 1; + unsigned WideBus16Bit : 1; + unsigned WideBus32Bit : 1; + unsigned RelAddr : 1; + + uint8_t VendorID[8]; + uint8_t ProductID[16]; + uint8_t RevisionID[4]; + } MS_SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t; + + /** Type define for a SCSI sense structure to a SCSI REQUEST SENSE command. For details of the + * structure contents, refer to the SCSI specifications. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t ResponseCode; + + uint8_t SegmentNumber; + + unsigned SenseKey : 4; + unsigned Reserved : 1; + unsigned ILI : 1; + unsigned EOM : 1; + unsigned FileMark : 1; + + uint8_t Information[4]; + uint8_t AdditionalLength; + uint8_t CmdSpecificInformation[4]; + uint8_t AdditionalSenseCode; + uint8_t AdditionalSenseQualifier; + uint8_t FieldReplaceableUnitCode; + uint8_t SenseKeySpecific[3]; + } MS_SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + bool SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(void); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_SCSI_C) + static bool SCSI_Command_Inquiry(void); + static bool SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(void); + static bool SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(void); + static bool SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(void); + static bool SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(const bool IsDataRead); + static bool SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(void); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/MassStorage.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/MassStorage.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f30969c671 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/MassStorage.c @@ -0,0 +1,332 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the Mass Storage demo. This file contains the main tasks of the demo and + * is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_MASSSTORAGE_C +#include "MassStorage.h" + +/** Structure to hold the latest Command Block Wrapper issued by the host, containing a SCSI command to execute. */ +MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t CommandBlock; + +/** Structure to hold the latest Command Status Wrapper to return to the host, containing the status of the last issued command. */ +MS_CommandStatusWrapper_t CommandStatus = { .Signature = MS_CSW_SIGNATURE }; + +/** Flag to asynchronously abort any in-progress data transfers upon the reception of a mass storage reset command. */ +volatile bool IsMassStoreReset = false; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + MassStorage_Task(); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + Dataflash_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Check if the Dataflash is working, abort if not */ + if (!(DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation())) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); + } + + /* Clear Dataflash sector protections, if enabled */ + DataflashManager_ResetDataflashProtections(); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB enumerating */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + /* Reset the MSReset flag upon connection */ + IsMassStoreReset = false; +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via + * the status LEDs and stops the Mass Storage management task. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB not ready */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This is fired when the host set the current configuration + * of the USB device after enumeration - the device endpoints are configured and the Mass Storage management task started. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + /* Setup Mass Storage Data Endpoints */ + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, 1); + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, 1); + + /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to + * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing + * internally. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + /* Process UFI specific control requests */ + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case MS_REQ_MassStorageReset: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + /* Indicate that the current transfer should be aborted */ + IsMassStoreReset = true; + } + + break; + case MS_REQ_GetMaxLUN: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Indicate to the host the number of supported LUNs (virtual disks) on the device */ + Endpoint_Write_8(TOTAL_LUNS - 1); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + } +} + +/** Task to manage the Mass Storage interface, reading in Command Block Wrappers from the host, processing the SCSI commands they + * contain, and returning Command Status Wrappers back to the host to indicate the success or failure of the last issued command. + */ +void MassStorage_Task(void) +{ + /* Device must be connected and configured for the task to run */ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Process sent command block from the host if one has been sent */ + if (ReadInCommandBlock()) + { + /* Indicate busy */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + + /* Check direction of command, select Data IN endpoint if data is from the device */ + if (CommandBlock.Flags & MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_IN) + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR); + + /* Decode the received SCSI command, set returned status code */ + CommandStatus.Status = SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand() ? MS_SCSI_COMMAND_Pass : MS_SCSI_COMMAND_Fail; + + /* Load in the CBW tag into the CSW to link them together */ + CommandStatus.Tag = CommandBlock.Tag; + + /* Load in the data residue counter into the CSW */ + CommandStatus.DataTransferResidue = CommandBlock.DataTransferLength; + + /* Stall the selected data pipe if command failed (if data is still to be transferred) */ + if ((CommandStatus.Status == MS_SCSI_COMMAND_Fail) && (CommandStatus.DataTransferResidue)) + Endpoint_StallTransaction(); + + /* Return command status block to the host */ + ReturnCommandStatus(); + + /* Indicate ready */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + } + + /* Check if a Mass Storage Reset occurred */ + if (IsMassStoreReset) + { + /* Reset the data endpoint banks */ + Endpoint_ResetEndpoint(MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR); + Endpoint_ResetEndpoint(MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR); + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR); + Endpoint_ClearStall(); + Endpoint_ResetDataToggle(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_ClearStall(); + Endpoint_ResetDataToggle(); + + /* Clear the abort transfer flag */ + IsMassStoreReset = false; + } +} + +/** Function to read in a command block from the host, via the bulk data OUT endpoint. This function reads in the next command block + * if one has been issued, and performs validation to ensure that the block command is valid. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if a valid command block has been read in from the endpoint, \c false otherwise + */ +static bool ReadInCommandBlock(void) +{ + uint16_t BytesTransferred; + + /* Select the Data Out endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR); + + /* Abort if no command has been sent from the host */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) + return false; + + /* Read in command block header */ + BytesTransferred = 0; + while (Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&CommandBlock, (sizeof(CommandBlock) - sizeof(CommandBlock.SCSICommandData)), + &BytesTransferred) == ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + { + /* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ + if (IsMassStoreReset) + return false; + } + + /* Verify the command block - abort if invalid */ + if ((CommandBlock.Signature != MS_CBW_SIGNATURE) || + (CommandBlock.LUN >= TOTAL_LUNS) || + (CommandBlock.Flags & 0x1F) || + (CommandBlock.SCSICommandLength == 0) || + (CommandBlock.SCSICommandLength > sizeof(CommandBlock.SCSICommandData))) + { + /* Stall both data pipes until reset by host */ + Endpoint_StallTransaction(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_StallTransaction(); + + return false; + } + + /* Read in command block command data */ + BytesTransferred = 0; + while (Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&CommandBlock.SCSICommandData, CommandBlock.SCSICommandLength, + &BytesTransferred) == ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + { + /* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ + if (IsMassStoreReset) + return false; + } + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + return true; +} + +/** Returns the filled Command Status Wrapper back to the host via the bulk data IN endpoint, waiting for the host to clear any + * stalled data endpoints as needed. + */ +static void ReturnCommandStatus(void) +{ + uint16_t BytesTransferred; + + /* Select the Data Out endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR); + + /* While data pipe is stalled, wait until the host issues a control request to clear the stall */ + while (Endpoint_IsStalled()) + { + /* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ + if (IsMassStoreReset) + return; + } + + /* Select the Data In endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR); + + /* While data pipe is stalled, wait until the host issues a control request to clear the stall */ + while (Endpoint_IsStalled()) + { + /* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ + if (IsMassStoreReset) + return; + } + + /* Write the CSW to the endpoint */ + BytesTransferred = 0; + while (Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&CommandStatus, sizeof(CommandStatus), + &BytesTransferred) == ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + { + /* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ + if (IsMassStoreReset) + return; + } + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/MassStorage.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/MassStorage.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f59e18735a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/MassStorage.h @@ -0,0 +1,92 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for MassStorage.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MASS_STORAGE_H_ +#define _MASS_STORAGE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include "Lib/SCSI.h" + #include "Lib/DataflashManager.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 + + /* Global Variables: */ + extern MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t CommandBlock; + extern MS_CommandStatusWrapper_t CommandStatus; + extern volatile bool IsMassStoreReset; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void MassStorage_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_MASSSTORAGE_C) + static bool ReadInCommandBlock(void); + static void ReturnCommandStatus(void); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/MassStorage.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/MassStorage.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b070dc83a2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/MassStorage.txt @@ -0,0 +1,100 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Mass Storage Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Mass Storage Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Bulk-Only Transport</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Mass Storage Standard \n + * USB Bulk-Only Transport Standard \n + * SCSI Primary Commands Specification \n + * SCSI Block Commands Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Mass Storage device demonstration application. This gives a simple + * reference application for implementing a USB Mass Storage device using + * the basic USB UFI drivers in all modern OSes (i.e. no special drivers + * required). + * + * On start-up the system will automatically enumerate and function as an + * external mass storage device which may be formatted and used in the same + * manner as commercial USB Mass Storage devices. + * + * You will need to format the mass storage drive upon first run of this + * demonstration - as the device acts only as a data block transport between + * the host and the storage media, it does not matter what file system is used, + * as the data interpretation is performed by the host and not the USB device. + * + * This demo is not restricted to only a single LUN (logical disk); by changing + * the TOTAL_LUNS value in DataflashManager.h, any number of LUNs can be used + * (from 1 to 255), with each LUN being allocated an equal portion of the available + * Dataflash memory. + * + * The USB control endpoint is managed entirely by the library using endpoint + * interrupts, as the INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT option is enabled. This allows for + * the host to reset the Mass Storage device state during long transfers without + * the need for complicated polling logic. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>TOTAL_LUNS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Total number of Logical Units (drives) in the device. The total device capacity is shared equally between each drive + * - this can be set to any positive non-zero amount.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>DISK_READ_ONLY</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Indicates if the disk should be write protected or not.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..68ae2c28ed --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,67 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Mass Storage Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.mass_storage.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.mass_storage"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Mass Storage Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.mass_storage.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.mass_storage"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.mass_storage" caption="Mass Storage Device Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Mass Storage device demo, implementing a basic USB storage disk using a Dataflash memory IC. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="Mass Storage Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="MassStorage.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="MassStorage.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/DataflashManager.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/SCSI.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="MassStorage.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/DataflashManager.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/SCSI.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.dataflash"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..84c2d3d0b6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Mass Storage Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..58646499f9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/MassStorage/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = MassStorage +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c Lib/DataflashManager.c Lib/SCSI.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..299d2ec852 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 1 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..368ddc66ed --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,240 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the + * USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This + * descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding) + * the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for + * more details on HID report descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t PROGMEM MouseReport[] = +{ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x01), /* Generic Desktop */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x02), /* Mouse */ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x01), /* Application */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x01), /* Pointer */ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x00), /* Physical */ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x09), /* Button */ + HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(8, 0x03), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x03), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x05), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_CONSTANT), + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x01), /* Generic Desktop */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x30), /* Usage X */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x31), /* Usage Y */ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, -1), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 1), + HID_RI_PHYSICAL_MINIMUM(8, -1), + HID_RI_PHYSICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 1), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x02), + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x08), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_RELATIVE), + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0), + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0), +}; + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2041, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .HID_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Mouse, + .AlternateSetting = 0x00, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_BootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_MouseBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID_MouseHID = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(MouseReport) + }, + + .HID_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MOUSE_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MOUSE_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Mouse Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + case HID_DTYPE_HID: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID_MouseHID; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + break; + case HID_DTYPE_Report: + Address = &MouseReport; + Size = sizeof(MouseReport); + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b3fc968908 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Mouse HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define MOUSE_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Size in bytes of the Mouse HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define MOUSE_EPSIZE 8 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Mouse HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID_Interface; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID_MouseHID; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID_ReportINEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_Mouse = 0, /**< Mouse interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/Mouse.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/Mouse.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0065a9bb4b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/Mouse.c @@ -0,0 +1,311 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the Mouse demo. This file contains the main tasks of the demo and + * is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "Mouse.h" + +/** Indicates what report mode the host has requested, true for normal HID reporting mode, \c false for special boot + * protocol reporting mode. + */ +static bool UsingReportProtocol = true; + +/** Current Idle period. This is set by the host via a Set Idle HID class request to silence the device's reports + * for either the entire idle duration, or until the report status changes (e.g. the user moves the mouse). + */ +static uint16_t IdleCount = 0; + +/** Current Idle period remaining. When the IdleCount value is set, this tracks the remaining number of idle + * milliseconds. This is separate to the IdleCount timer and is incremented and compared as the host may request + * the current idle period via a Get Idle HID class request, thus its value must be preserved. + */ +static uint16_t IdleMSRemaining = 0; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + Mouse_Task(); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Joystick_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + Buttons_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB enumerating */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + /* Default to report protocol on connect */ + UsingReportProtocol = true; +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via + * the status LEDs and stops the USB management and Mouse reporting tasks. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB not ready */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This is fired when the host sets the current configuration + * of the USB device after enumeration - the device endpoints are configured and the mouse reporting task started. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + /* Setup HID Report Endpoint */ + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(MOUSE_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, MOUSE_EPSIZE, 1); + + /* Turn on Start-of-Frame events for tracking HID report period expiry */ + USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(); + + /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to + * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing + * internally. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + /* Handle HID Class specific requests */ + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case HID_REQ_GetReport: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + USB_MouseReport_Data_t MouseReportData; + + /* Create the next mouse report for transmission to the host */ + CreateMouseReport(&MouseReportData); + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Write the report data to the control endpoint */ + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(&MouseReportData, sizeof(MouseReportData)); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + /* Clear the report data afterwards */ + memset(&MouseReportData, 0, sizeof(MouseReportData)); + } + + break; + case HID_REQ_GetProtocol: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Write the current protocol flag to the host */ + Endpoint_Write_8(UsingReportProtocol); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + case HID_REQ_SetProtocol: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + /* Set or clear the flag depending on what the host indicates that the current Protocol should be */ + UsingReportProtocol = (USB_ControlRequest.wValue != 0); + } + + break; + case HID_REQ_SetIdle: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + /* Get idle period in MSB, must multiply by 4 to get the duration in milliseconds */ + IdleCount = ((USB_ControlRequest.wValue & 0xFF00) >> 6); + } + + break; + case HID_REQ_GetIdle: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Write the current idle duration to the host, must be divided by 4 before sent to host */ + Endpoint_Write_8(IdleCount >> 2); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + } +} + +/** Event handler for the USB device Start Of Frame event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void) +{ + /* One millisecond has elapsed, decrement the idle time remaining counter if it has not already elapsed */ + if (IdleMSRemaining) + IdleMSRemaining--; +} + +/** Fills the given HID report data structure with the next HID report to send to the host. + * + * \param[out] ReportData Pointer to a HID report data structure to be filled + */ +void CreateMouseReport(USB_MouseReport_Data_t* const ReportData) +{ + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + uint8_t ButtonStatus_LCL = Buttons_GetStatus(); + + /* Clear the report contents */ + memset(ReportData, 0, sizeof(USB_MouseReport_Data_t)); + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + ReportData->Y = -1; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + ReportData->Y = 1; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + ReportData->X = -1; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + ReportData->X = 1; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + ReportData->Button |= (1 << 0); + + if (ButtonStatus_LCL & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) + ReportData->Button |= (1 << 1); +} + +/** Sends the next HID report to the host, via the keyboard data endpoint. */ +void SendNextReport(void) +{ + static USB_MouseReport_Data_t PrevMouseReportData; + USB_MouseReport_Data_t MouseReportData; + bool SendReport; + + /* Create the next mouse report for transmission to the host */ + CreateMouseReport(&MouseReportData); + + /* Check to see if the report data has changed - if so a report MUST be sent */ + SendReport = (memcmp(&PrevMouseReportData, &MouseReportData, sizeof(USB_MouseReport_Data_t)) != 0); + + /* Override the check if the Y or X values are non-zero - we want continuous movement while the joystick + * is being held down (via continuous reports), otherwise the cursor will only move once per joystick toggle */ + if ((MouseReportData.Y != 0) || (MouseReportData.X != 0)) + SendReport = true; + + /* Check if the idle period is set and has elapsed */ + if (IdleCount && (!(IdleMSRemaining))) + { + /* Reset the idle time remaining counter */ + IdleMSRemaining = IdleCount; + + /* Idle period is set and has elapsed, must send a report to the host */ + SendReport = true; + } + + /* Select the Mouse Report Endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MOUSE_EPADDR); + + /* Check if Mouse Endpoint Ready for Read/Write and if we should send a new report */ + if (Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed() && SendReport) + { + /* Save the current report data for later comparison to check for changes */ + PrevMouseReportData = MouseReportData; + + /* Write Mouse Report Data */ + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&MouseReportData, sizeof(MouseReportData), NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } +} + +/** Task to manage HID report generation and transmission to the host, when in report mode. */ +void Mouse_Task(void) +{ + /* Device must be connected and configured for the task to run */ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Send the next mouse report to the host */ + SendNextReport(); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/Mouse.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/Mouse.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9d72b79776 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/Mouse.h @@ -0,0 +1,81 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Mouse.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MOUSE_H_ +#define _MOUSE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void Mouse_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void); + + void CreateMouseReport(USB_MouseReport_Data_t* const ReportData); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/Mouse.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/Mouse.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7246ede31e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/Mouse.txt @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Mouse Device Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Mouse demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Mouse using the basic USB HID + * drivers in all modern OSes (i.e. no special drivers required). It is + * boot protocol compatible, and thus works under compatible BIOS as if + * it was a native mouse (e.g. PS/2). + * + * On start-up the system will automatically enumerate and function + * as a mouse when the USB connection to a host is present. To use + * the mouse, move the joystick to move the pointer, and push the + * joystick inwards to simulate a left-button click. The HWB serves as + * the right mouse button. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ac21d0771a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Mouse HID Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.mouse.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.mouse"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Mouse HID Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.mouse.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.mouse"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.mouse" caption="Mouse HID Device Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Mouse device demo, implementing a basic USB mouse device that can send movement information to the host. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="Mouse.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Mouse.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Mouse.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..37bc830184 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Mouse Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..37303b3e4f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/Mouse/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = Mouse +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0e4d1780a9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,60 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define CLIENT_IP_ADDRESS { 10, 0, 0, 1} + #define SERVER_IP_ADDRESS { 10, 0, 0, 2} + + #define ADAPTER_MAC_ADDRESS {0x02, 0x00, 0x02, 0x00, 0x02, 0x00} + #define SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS {0x00, 0x01, 0x00, 0x01, 0x00, 0x01} + + #define NO_DECODE_ETHERNET + #define NO_DECODE_ARP + #define NO_DECODE_IP + #define NO_DECODE_ICMP + #define NO_DECODE_TCP + #define NO_DECODE_UDP + #define NO_DECODE_DHCP + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cc828a108d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 3 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e42b318602 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,244 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x204C, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .CDC_CCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_VendorSpecificProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Header = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .CDCSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + }, + + .CDC_Functional_ACM = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ACM, + + .Capabilities = 0x00, + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Union = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Union, + + .MasterInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .SlaveInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + }, + + .CDC_NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0xFF + }, + + .CDC_DCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .RNDIS_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .RNDIS_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA RNDIS CDC Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..84c336f169 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,112 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_TX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define CDC_RX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC data IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE 64 + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE 8 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // RNDIS CDC Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_CCI_Interface; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t CDC_Functional_Header; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t CDC_Functional_ACM; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t CDC_Functional_Union; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_NotificationEndpoint; + + // RNDIS CDC Data Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_DCI_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t RNDIS_DataOutEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t RNDIS_DataInEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI = 0, /**< CDC CCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI = 1, /**< CDC DCI interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/LUFA RNDIS.inf b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/LUFA RNDIS.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f34e55f995 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/LUFA RNDIS.inf @@ -0,0 +1,59 @@ +; Windows LUFA RNDIS Setup File +; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation + +[DefaultInstall] +CopyINF="LUFA RNDIS.inf" + +[Version] +Signature="$Windows NT$" +Class=Net +ClassGuid={4d36e972-e325-11ce-bfc1-08002be10318} +Provider=%MFGNAME% +DriverVer=7/1/2012,10.0.0.0 + +[Manufacturer] +%MFGNAME%=DeviceList, NTx86, NTamd64, NTia64 + +[ControlFlags] +ExcludeFromSelect=* + +[DriverInstall] +Characteristics=0x84 ; NCF_PHYSICAL + NCF_HAS_UI +BusType=15 +include=netrndis.inf +needs=Usb_Rndis.ndi +AddReg=Rndis_AddReg_Vista + +[DriverInstall.Services] +include=netrndis.inf +needs=Usb_Rndis.ndi.Services + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; Vendor and Product ID Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; When developing your USB device, the VID and PID used in the PC side +; application program and the firmware on the microcontroller must match. +; Modify the below line to use your VID and PID. Use the format as shown below. +; Note: One INF file can be used for multiple devices with different VID and PIDs. +; For each supported device, append ",USB\VID_xxxx&PID_yyyy" to the end of the line. +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[DeviceList] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204C + +[DeviceList.NTx86] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204C + +[DeviceList.NTamd64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204C + +[DeviceList.NTia64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204C + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; String Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +;Modify these strings to customize your device +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[Strings] +MFGNAME="http://www.lufa-lib.org" +DESCRIPTION="LUFA USB RNDIS Demo" diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ARP.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ARP.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..24008705c1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ARP.c @@ -0,0 +1,87 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) packet handling routines. This protocol handles the + * conversion of physical MAC addresses to protocol IP addresses between the host and the + * device. + */ + +#include "ARP.h" + +/** Processes an ARP packet inside an Ethernet frame, and writes the appropriate response + * to the output Ethernet frame if the host is requesting the IP or MAC address of the + * virtual server device on the network. + * + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of the incoming packet's ARP header + * \param[out] OutDataStart Pointer to the start of the outgoing packet's ARP header + * + * \return The number of bytes written to the out Ethernet frame if any, NO_RESPONSE otherwise + */ +int16_t ARP_ProcessARPPacket(void* InDataStart, + void* OutDataStart) +{ + DecodeARPHeader(InDataStart); + + ARP_Header_t* ARPHeaderIN = (ARP_Header_t*)InDataStart; + ARP_Header_t* ARPHeaderOUT = (ARP_Header_t*)OutDataStart; + + /* Ensure that the ARP request is a IPv4 request packet */ + if ((SwapEndian_16(ARPHeaderIN->ProtocolType) == ETHERTYPE_IPV4) && + (SwapEndian_16(ARPHeaderIN->Operation) == ARP_OPERATION_REQUEST)) + { + /* If the ARP packet is requesting the MAC or IP of the virtual webserver, return the response */ + if (IP_COMPARE(&ARPHeaderIN->TPA, &ServerIPAddress) || + MAC_COMPARE(&ARPHeaderIN->THA, &ServerMACAddress)) + { + /* Fill out the ARP response header */ + ARPHeaderOUT->HardwareType = ARPHeaderIN->HardwareType; + ARPHeaderOUT->ProtocolType = ARPHeaderIN->ProtocolType; + ARPHeaderOUT->HLEN = ARPHeaderIN->HLEN; + ARPHeaderOUT->PLEN = ARPHeaderIN->PLEN; + ARPHeaderOUT->Operation = SwapEndian_16(ARP_OPERATION_REPLY); + + /* Copy over the sender MAC/IP to the target fields for the response */ + ARPHeaderOUT->THA = ARPHeaderIN->SHA; + ARPHeaderOUT->TPA = ARPHeaderIN->SPA; + + /* Copy over the new sender MAC/IP - MAC and IP addresses of the virtual webserver */ + ARPHeaderOUT->SHA = ServerMACAddress; + ARPHeaderOUT->SPA = ServerIPAddress; + + /* Return the size of the response so far */ + return sizeof(ARP_Header_t); + } + } + + return NO_RESPONSE; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ARP.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ARP.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c809cbf44a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ARP.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ARP.c. + */ + +#ifndef _ARP_H_ +#define _ARP_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "EthernetProtocols.h" + #include "Ethernet.h" + #include "ProtocolDecoders.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** ARP header operation constant, indicating a request from a host for an address translation. */ + #define ARP_OPERATION_REQUEST 1 + + /** ARP header operation constant, indicating a reply from a host giving an address translation. */ + #define ARP_OPERATION_REPLY 2 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for an ARP packet inside an Ethernet frame. */ + typedef struct + { + uint16_t HardwareType; /**< Hardware type constant, indicating the hardware used */ + uint16_t ProtocolType; /**< Protocol being resolved, usually ETHERTYPE_IPV4 */ + + uint8_t HLEN; /**< Length in bytes of the source/destination hardware addresses */ + uint8_t PLEN; /**< Length in bytes of the source/destination protocol addresses */ + uint16_t Operation; /**< Type of operation, either ARP_OPERATION_REQUEST or ARP_OPERATION_REPLY */ + + MAC_Address_t SHA; /**< Sender's hardware address */ + IP_Address_t SPA; /**< Sender's protocol address */ + MAC_Address_t THA; /**< Target's hardware address */ + IP_Address_t TPA; /**< Target's protocol address */ + } ARP_Header_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + int16_t ARP_ProcessARPPacket(void* InDataStart, + void* OutDataStart); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/DHCP.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/DHCP.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6f7b40af69 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/DHCP.c @@ -0,0 +1,129 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) packet handling routines. This protocol + * handles the automatic IP negotiation to the host, so that the host will use the provided + * IP address given to it by the device. + */ + +#include "DHCP.h" + +/** Processes a DHCP packet inside an Ethernet frame, and writes the appropriate response + * to the output Ethernet frame if the host is requesting or accepting an IP address. + * + * \param[in] IPHeaderInStart Pointer to the start of the incoming packet's IP header + * \param[in] DHCPHeaderInStart Pointer to the start of the incoming packet's DHCP header + * \param[out] DHCPHeaderOutStart Pointer to the start of the outgoing packet's DHCP header + * + * \return The number of bytes written to the out Ethernet frame if any, NO_RESPONSE otherwise + */ +int16_t DHCP_ProcessDHCPPacket(void* IPHeaderInStart, + void* DHCPHeaderInStart, + void* DHCPHeaderOutStart) +{ + IP_Header_t* IPHeaderIN = (IP_Header_t*)IPHeaderInStart; + DHCP_Header_t* DHCPHeaderIN = (DHCP_Header_t*)DHCPHeaderInStart; + DHCP_Header_t* DHCPHeaderOUT = (DHCP_Header_t*)DHCPHeaderOutStart; + + uint8_t* DHCPOptionsINStart = (uint8_t*)(DHCPHeaderInStart + sizeof(DHCP_Header_t)); + uint8_t* DHCPOptionsOUTStart = (uint8_t*)(DHCPHeaderOutStart + sizeof(DHCP_Header_t)); + + DecodeDHCPHeader(DHCPHeaderInStart); + + /* Zero out the response DHCP packet, as much of it is legacy and left at 0 */ + memset(DHCPHeaderOUT, 0, sizeof(DHCP_Header_t)); + + /* Fill out the response DHCP packet */ + DHCPHeaderOUT->HardwareType = DHCPHeaderIN->HardwareType; + DHCPHeaderOUT->Operation = DHCP_OP_BOOTREPLY; + DHCPHeaderOUT->HardwareAddressLength = DHCPHeaderIN->HardwareAddressLength; + DHCPHeaderOUT->Hops = 0; + DHCPHeaderOUT->TransactionID = DHCPHeaderIN->TransactionID; + DHCPHeaderOUT->ElapsedSeconds = 0; + DHCPHeaderOUT->Flags = DHCPHeaderIN->Flags; + DHCPHeaderOUT->YourIP = ClientIPAddress; + memmove(&DHCPHeaderOUT->ClientHardwareAddress, &DHCPHeaderIN->ClientHardwareAddress, sizeof(MAC_Address_t)); + DHCPHeaderOUT->Cookie = SwapEndian_32(DHCP_MAGIC_COOKIE); + + /* Alter the incoming IP packet header so that the corrected IP source and destinations are used - this means that + when the response IP header is generated, it will use the corrected addresses and not the null/broatcast addresses */ + IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress = ClientIPAddress; + IPHeaderIN->DestinationAddress = ServerIPAddress; + + /* Process the incoming DHCP packet options */ + while (DHCPOptionsINStart[0] != DHCP_OPTION_END) + { + /* Find the Message Type DHCP option, to determine the type of DHCP packet */ + if (DHCPOptionsINStart[0] == DHCP_OPTION_MESSAGETYPE) + { + if ((DHCPOptionsINStart[2] == DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_DISCOVER) || (DHCPOptionsINStart[2] == DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_REQUEST)) + { + /* Fill out the response DHCP packet options for a DHCP OFFER or ACK response */ + + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = DHCP_OPTION_MESSAGETYPE; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = 1; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = (DHCPOptionsINStart[2] == DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_DISCOVER) ? DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_OFFER + : DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_ACK; + + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = DHCP_OPTION_SUBNETMASK; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = sizeof(IP_Address_t); + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = 0xFF; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = 0xFF; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = 0xFF; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = 0x00; + + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = DHCP_OPTION_LEASETIME; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = sizeof(uint32_t); + /* Lease Time 86400s (ONE_DAY) */ + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = 0x00; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = 0x01; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = 0x51; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = 0x80; + + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = DHCP_OPTION_DHCPSERVER; + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = sizeof(IP_Address_t); + memcpy(DHCPOptionsOUTStart, &ServerIPAddress, sizeof(IP_Address_t)); + DHCPOptionsOUTStart += sizeof(IP_Address_t); + + *(DHCPOptionsOUTStart++) = DHCP_OPTION_END; + + return (sizeof(DHCP_Header_t) + 18 + sizeof(IP_Address_t)); + } + } + + /* Go to the next DHCP option - skip one byte if option is a padding byte, else skip the complete option's size */ + DHCPOptionsINStart += ((DHCPOptionsINStart[0] == DHCP_OPTION_PAD) ? 1 : (DHCPOptionsINStart[1] + 2)); + } + + return NO_RESPONSE; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/DHCP.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/DHCP.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5ef78469ec --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/DHCP.h @@ -0,0 +1,131 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for DHCP.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DHCP_H_ +#define _DHCP_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "EthernetProtocols.h" + #include "Ethernet.h" + #include "ProtocolDecoders.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** DHCP operation constant, indicating a request from a host to a DHCP server. */ + #define DHCP_OP_BOOTREQUEST 0x01 + + /** DHCP operation constant, indicating a reply from a DHCP server to a host. */ + #define DHCP_OP_BOOTREPLY 0x02 + + /** Hardware type constant, indicating Ethernet as a carrier. */ + #define DHCP_HTYPE_ETHERNET 0x01 + + /** Magic boot protocol "cookie", inserted into all BOOTP packets (BOOTP is the carrier of DHCP). */ + #define DHCP_MAGIC_COOKIE 0x63825363 + + /** DHCP option list entry header, indicating that a subnet mask will follow. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_SUBNETMASK 1 + + /** DHCP option list entry header, indicating that the Lease Time will follow. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_LEASETIME 51 + + /** DHCP option list entry header, indicating that the DHCP message type constant will follow. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_MESSAGETYPE 53 + + /** DHCP option list entry header, indicating that the IP address of the DHCP server will follow. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_DHCPSERVER 54 + + /** DHCP option list entry header, used to pad out option data. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_PAD 0 + + /** DHCP option list entry header, indicating the end of option data. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_END 255 + + /** Message type constant, used in the DHCP option data field, requesting that a DHCP server offer an IP address. */ + #define DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_DISCOVER 1 + + /** Message type constant, used in the DHCP option data field, indicating that a DHCP server is offering an IP address. */ + #define DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_OFFER 2 + + /** Message type constant, used in the DHCP option data field, requesting that a DHCP server lease a given IP address. */ + #define DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_REQUEST 3 + + /** Message type constant, used in the DHCP option data field, declining an offered DHCP server IP address lease. */ + #define DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_DECLINE 4 + + /** Message type constant, used in the DHCP option data field, ACKing a host IP lease request. */ + #define DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_ACK 5 + + /** Message type constant, used in the DHCP option data field, NACKing a host IP lease request. */ + #define DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_NACK 6 + + /** Message type constant, used in the DHCP option data field, indicating that a host is releasing a leased IP address. */ + #define DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_RELEASE 7 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a DHCP packet inside an Ethernet frame. */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Operation; /**< DHCP operation, either DHCP_OP_BOOTREQUEST or DHCP_OP_BOOTREPLY */ + uint8_t HardwareType; /**< Hardware carrier type constant */ + uint8_t HardwareAddressLength; /**< Length in bytes of a hardware (MAC) address on the network */ + uint8_t Hops; /**< Number of hops required to reach the server, unused */ + + uint32_t TransactionID; /**< Unique ID of the DHCP packet, for positive matching between sent and received packets */ + + uint16_t ElapsedSeconds; /**< Elapsed seconds since the request was made */ + uint16_t Flags; /**< BOOTP packet flags */ + + IP_Address_t ClientIP; /**< Client IP address, if already leased an IP */ + IP_Address_t YourIP; /**< Client IP address */ + IP_Address_t NextServerIP; /**< Legacy BOOTP protocol field, unused for DHCP */ + IP_Address_t RelayAgentIP; /**< Legacy BOOTP protocol field, unused for DHCP */ + + uint8_t ClientHardwareAddress[16]; /**< Hardware (MAC) address of the client making a request to the DHCP server */ + uint8_t ServerHostnameString[64]; /**< Legacy BOOTP protocol field, unused for DHCP */ + uint8_t BootFileName[128]; /**< Legacy BOOTP protocol field, unused for DHCP */ + + uint32_t Cookie; /**< Magic BOOTP protocol cookie to indicate a valid packet */ + } DHCP_Header_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + int16_t DHCP_ProcessDHCPPacket(void* IPHeaderInStart, + void* DHCPHeaderInStart, + void* DHCPHeaderOutStart); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Ethernet.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Ethernet.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a48de2c717 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Ethernet.c @@ -0,0 +1,136 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Ethernet frame packet handling routines. This protocol handles the processing of raw Ethernet + * frames sent and received, deferring the processing of sub-packet protocols to the appropriate + * protocol handlers, such as DHCP or ARP. + */ + +#include "Ethernet.h" + +/** Ethernet Frame buffer structure, to hold the incoming Ethernet frame from the host. */ +Ethernet_Frame_Info_t FrameIN; + +/** Ethernet Frame buffer structure, to hold the outgoing Ethernet frame to the host. */ +Ethernet_Frame_Info_t FrameOUT; + +/** Constant for convenience when checking against or setting a MAC address to the virtual server MAC address. */ +const MAC_Address_t ServerMACAddress = {SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS}; + +/** Constant for convenience when checking against or setting an IP address to the virtual server IP address. */ +const IP_Address_t ServerIPAddress = {SERVER_IP_ADDRESS}; + +/** Constant for convenience when checking against or setting a MAC address to the broadcast MAC address. */ +const MAC_Address_t BroadcastMACAddress = {BROADCAST_MAC_ADDRESS}; + +/** Constant for convenience when checking against or setting a IP address to the broadcast IP address. */ +const IP_Address_t BroadcastIPAddress = {BROADCAST_IP_ADDRESS}; + +/** Constant for convenience when checking against or setting an IP address to the client (host) IP address. */ +const IP_Address_t ClientIPAddress = {CLIENT_IP_ADDRESS}; + + +/** Processes an incoming Ethernet frame, and writes the appropriate response to the output Ethernet + * frame buffer if the sub protocol handlers create a valid response. + */ +void Ethernet_ProcessPacket(void) +{ + DecodeEthernetFrameHeader(FrameIN.FrameData); + + /* Cast the incoming Ethernet frame to the Ethernet header type */ + Ethernet_Frame_Header_t* FrameINHeader = (Ethernet_Frame_Header_t*)&FrameIN.FrameData; + Ethernet_Frame_Header_t* FrameOUTHeader = (Ethernet_Frame_Header_t*)&FrameOUT.FrameData; + + int16_t RetSize = NO_RESPONSE; + + /* Ensure frame is addressed to either all (broadcast) or the virtual webserver, and is a type II frame */ + if ((MAC_COMPARE(&FrameINHeader->Destination, &ServerMACAddress) || + MAC_COMPARE(&FrameINHeader->Destination, &BroadcastMACAddress)) && + (SwapEndian_16(FrameIN.FrameLength) > ETHERNET_VER2_MINSIZE)) + { + /* Process the packet depending on its protocol */ + switch (SwapEndian_16(FrameINHeader->EtherType)) + { + case ETHERTYPE_ARP: + RetSize = ARP_ProcessARPPacket(&FrameIN.FrameData[sizeof(Ethernet_Frame_Header_t)], + &FrameOUT.FrameData[sizeof(Ethernet_Frame_Header_t)]); + break; + case ETHERTYPE_IPV4: + RetSize = IP_ProcessIPPacket(&FrameIN.FrameData[sizeof(Ethernet_Frame_Header_t)], + &FrameOUT.FrameData[sizeof(Ethernet_Frame_Header_t)]); + break; + } + + /* Protocol processing routine has filled a response, complete the ethernet frame header */ + if (RetSize > 0) + { + /* Fill out the response Ethernet frame header */ + FrameOUTHeader->Source = ServerMACAddress; + FrameOUTHeader->Destination = FrameINHeader->Source; + FrameOUTHeader->EtherType = FrameINHeader->EtherType; + + /* Set the response length in the buffer and indicate that a response is ready to be sent */ + FrameOUT.FrameLength = (sizeof(Ethernet_Frame_Header_t) + RetSize); + } + } + + /* Check if the packet was processed */ + if (RetSize != NO_PROCESS) + { + /* Clear the frame buffer */ + FrameIN.FrameLength = 0; + } +} + +/** Calculates the appropriate ethernet checksum, consisting of the addition of the one's + * compliment of each word, complimented. + * + * \param[in] Data Pointer to the packet buffer data whose checksum must be calculated + * \param[in] Bytes Number of bytes in the data buffer to process + * + * \return A 16-bit Ethernet checksum value + */ +uint16_t Ethernet_Checksum16(void* Data, + uint16_t Bytes) +{ + uint16_t* Words = (uint16_t*)Data; + uint32_t Checksum = 0; + + for (uint16_t CurrWord = 0; CurrWord < (Bytes >> 1); CurrWord++) + Checksum += Words[CurrWord]; + + while (Checksum & 0xFFFF0000) + Checksum = ((Checksum & 0xFFFF) + (Checksum >> 16)); + + return ~Checksum; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Ethernet.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Ethernet.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8eaf64080b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Ethernet.h @@ -0,0 +1,111 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Ethernet.c. + */ + +#ifndef _ETHERNET_H_ +#define _ETHERNET_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include "EthernetProtocols.h" + #include "ProtocolDecoders.h" + #include "ICMP.h" + #include "TCP.h" + #include "UDP.h" + #include "DHCP.h" + #include "ARP.h" + #include "IP.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Physical MAC address of the network broadcast address. */ + #define BROADCAST_MAC_ADDRESS {0xFF, 0xFF, 0xFF, 0xFF, 0xFF, 0xFF} + + /** Performs a comparison between two MAC addresses, indicating if they are identical. + * + * \param[in] MAC1 First MAC address + * \param[in] MAC2 Second MAC address + * + * \return True if the addresses match, \c false otherwise + */ + #define MAC_COMPARE(MAC1, MAC2) (memcmp(MAC1, MAC2, sizeof(MAC_Address_t)) == 0) + + /** Maximum size of an incoming or outgoing Ethernet frame in bytes. */ + #define ETHERNET_FRAME_SIZE_MAX 1500 + + /** Minimum size of an Ethernet packet in bytes, to conform to the Ethernet V2 packet standard. */ + #define ETHERNET_VER2_MINSIZE 0x0600 + + /** Return value for all sub protocol handling routines, indicating that no response packet has been generated. */ + #define NO_RESPONSE 0 + + /** Return value for all sub protocol handling routines, indicating that the packet has not yet been handled. */ + #define NO_PROCESS -1 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for an Ethernet frame buffer data and information structure. */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t FrameData[ETHERNET_FRAME_SIZE_MAX]; /**< Ethernet frame contents. */ + uint16_t FrameLength; /**< Length in bytes of the Ethernet frame stored in the buffer. */ + } Ethernet_Frame_Info_t; + + /** Type define for an Ethernet frame header. */ + typedef struct + { + MAC_Address_t Destination; /**< Physical MAC address of the packet recipient */ + MAC_Address_t Source; /**< Physics MAC address of the packet source */ + uint16_t EtherType; /**< Ethernet packet sub-protocol type, for Ethernet V2 packets */ + } Ethernet_Frame_Header_t; + + /* External Variables: */ + extern Ethernet_Frame_Info_t FrameIN; + extern Ethernet_Frame_Info_t FrameOUT; + + extern const MAC_Address_t ServerMACAddress; + extern const IP_Address_t ServerIPAddress; + extern const MAC_Address_t BroadcastMACAddress; + extern const IP_Address_t BroadcastIPAddress; + extern const IP_Address_t ClientIPAddress; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void Ethernet_ProcessPacket(void); + uint16_t Ethernet_Checksum16(void* Data, + uint16_t Bytes); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/EthernetProtocols.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/EthernetProtocols.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ca738cd0db --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/EthernetProtocols.h @@ -0,0 +1,88 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * General Ethernet protocol constants and type defines, for use by + * all network protocol portions of the TCP/IP stack. + */ + +#ifndef _ETHERNET_PROTOCOLS_H_ +#define _ETHERNET_PROTOCOLS_H_ + + /* Macros: */ + #define ETHERTYPE_IPV4 0x0800 + #define ETHERTYPE_ARP 0x0806 + #define ETHERTYPE_RARP 0x8035 + #define ETHERTYPE_APPLETALK 0x809b + #define ETHERTYPE_APPLETALKARP 0x80f3 + #define ETHERTYPE_IEEE8021Q 0x8100 + #define ETHERTYPE_NOVELLIPX 0x8137 + #define ETHERTYPE_NOVELL 0x8138 + #define ETHERTYPE_IPV6 0x86DD + #define ETHERTYPE_COBRANET 0x8819 + #define ETHERTYPE_PROVIDERBRIDGING 0x88a8 + #define ETHERTYPE_MPLSUNICAST 0x8847 + #define ETHERTYPE_MPLSMULTICAST 0x8848 + #define ETHERTYPE_PPPoEDISCOVERY 0x8863 + #define ETHERTYPE_PPPoESESSION 0x8864 + #define ETHERTYPE_EAPOVERLAN 0x888E + #define ETHERTYPE_HYPERSCSI 0x889A + #define ETHERTYPE_ATAOVERETHERNET 0x88A2 + #define ETHERTYPE_ETHERCAT 0x88A4 + #define ETHERTYPE_SERCOSIII 0x88CD + #define ETHERTYPE_CESoE 0x88D8 + #define ETHERTYPE_MACSECURITY 0x88E5 + #define ETHERTYPE_FIBRECHANNEL 0x8906 + #define ETHERTYPE_QINQ 0x9100 + #define ETHERTYPE_VLLT 0xCAFE + + #define PROTOCOL_ICMP 1 + #define PROTOCOL_IGMP 2 + #define PROTOCOL_TCP 6 + #define PROTOCOL_UDP 17 + #define PROTOCOL_OSPF 89 + #define PROTOCOL_SCTP 132 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a physical MAC address of a device on a network. */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Octets[6]; /**< Individual bytes of a MAC address */ + } RNDIS_MAC_Address_t; + + /** Type define for a protocol IP address of a device on a network. */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Octets[4]; /**< Individual bytes of an IP address */ + } IP_Address_t; + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ICMP.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ICMP.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b144c4c517 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ICMP.c @@ -0,0 +1,81 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packet handling routines. This protocol handles + * Echo requests from the host, to indicate a successful network connection between the host + * and the virtual server. + */ + +#include "ICMP.h" + +/** Processes an ICMP packet inside an Ethernet frame, and writes the appropriate response + * to the output Ethernet frame if the host is issuing a ICMP ECHO request. + * + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of the incoming packet's ICMP header + * \param[out] OutDataStart Pointer to the start of the outgoing packet's ICMP header + * + * \return The number of bytes written to the out Ethernet frame if any, NO_RESPONSE otherwise + */ +int16_t ICMP_ProcessICMPPacket(void* InDataStart, + void* OutDataStart) +{ + ICMP_Header_t* ICMPHeaderIN = (ICMP_Header_t*)InDataStart; + ICMP_Header_t* ICMPHeaderOUT = (ICMP_Header_t*)OutDataStart; + + DecodeICMPHeader(InDataStart); + + /* Determine if the ICMP packet is an echo request (ping) */ + if (ICMPHeaderIN->Type == ICMP_TYPE_ECHOREQUEST) + { + /* Fill out the ICMP response packet */ + ICMPHeaderOUT->Type = ICMP_TYPE_ECHOREPLY; + ICMPHeaderOUT->Code = 0; + ICMPHeaderOUT->Checksum = 0; + ICMPHeaderOUT->Id = ICMPHeaderIN->Id; + ICMPHeaderOUT->Sequence = ICMPHeaderIN->Sequence; + + intptr_t DataSize = FrameIN.FrameLength - ((((intptr_t)InDataStart + sizeof(ICMP_Header_t)) - (intptr_t)FrameIN.FrameData)); + + /* Copy the remaining payload to the response - echo requests should echo back any sent data */ + memmove(&((uint8_t*)OutDataStart)[sizeof(ICMP_Header_t)], + &((uint8_t*)InDataStart)[sizeof(ICMP_Header_t)], + DataSize); + + ICMPHeaderOUT->Checksum = Ethernet_Checksum16(ICMPHeaderOUT, (DataSize + sizeof(ICMP_Header_t))); + + /* Return the size of the response so far */ + return (DataSize + sizeof(ICMP_Header_t)); + } + + return NO_RESPONSE; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ICMP.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ICMP.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e8039da3e0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ICMP.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ICMP.c. + */ + +#ifndef _ICMP_H_ +#define _ICMP_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "EthernetProtocols.h" + #include "Ethernet.h" + #include "ProtocolDecoders.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** ICMP message type constant, indicating an ICMP ECHO Reply message. */ + #define ICMP_TYPE_ECHOREPLY 0 + + /** ICMP message type constant, indicating a packet destination is unreachable. */ + #define ICMP_TYPE_DESTINATIONUNREACHABLE 3 + + /** ICMP message type constant, indicating an ICMP Source Quench message. */ + #define ICMP_TYPE_SOURCEQUENCH 4 + + /** ICMP message type constant, indicating an ICMP Redirect message. */ + #define ICMP_TYPE_REDIRECTMESSAGE 5 + + /** ICMP message type constant, indicating an ICMP ECHO Request message. */ + #define ICMP_TYPE_ECHOREQUEST 8 + + /** ICMP message type constant, indicating an ICMP Time Exceeded message. */ + #define ICMP_TYPE_TIMEEXCEEDED 11 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for an ICMP message header. */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Type; /**< ICMP message type, an \c ICMP_TYPE_* constant */ + uint8_t Code; /**< ICMP message code, indicating the message value */ + uint16_t Checksum; /**< Ethernet checksum of the ICMP message */ + uint16_t Id; /**< Id of the ICMP message */ + uint16_t Sequence; /**< Sequence number of the ICMP message, to link together message responses */ + } ICMP_Header_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + int16_t ICMP_ProcessICMPPacket(void* InDataStart, + void* OutDataStart); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/IP.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/IP.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dfa583b853 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/IP.c @@ -0,0 +1,113 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Internet Protocol (IP) packet handling routines. This protocol handles IP packets from the + * host which typically encapsulate other protocols such as ICMP, UDP and TCP. + */ + +#include "IP.h" + +/** Processes an IP packet inside an Ethernet frame, and writes the appropriate response + * to the output Ethernet frame if one is created by a sub-protocol handler. + * + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of the incoming packet's IP header + * \param[out] OutDataStart Pointer to the start of the outgoing packet's IP header + * + * \return The number of bytes written to the out Ethernet frame if any, NO_RESPONSE if no + * response was generated, NO_PROCESS if the packet processing was deferred until the + * next Ethernet packet handler iteration + */ +int16_t IP_ProcessIPPacket(void* InDataStart, + void* OutDataStart) +{ + DecodeIPHeader(InDataStart); + + IP_Header_t* IPHeaderIN = (IP_Header_t*)InDataStart; + IP_Header_t* IPHeaderOUT = (IP_Header_t*)OutDataStart; + + /* Header length is specified in number of longs in the packet header, convert to bytes */ + uint16_t HeaderLengthBytes = (IPHeaderIN->HeaderLength * sizeof(uint32_t)); + + int16_t RetSize = NO_RESPONSE; + + /* Check to ensure the IP packet is addressed to the virtual webserver's IP or the broadcast IP address */ + if (!(IP_COMPARE(&IPHeaderIN->DestinationAddress, &ServerIPAddress)) && + !(IP_COMPARE(&IPHeaderIN->DestinationAddress, &BroadcastIPAddress))) + { + return NO_RESPONSE; + } + + /* Pass off the IP payload to the appropriate protocol processing routine */ + switch (IPHeaderIN->Protocol) + { + case PROTOCOL_ICMP: + RetSize = ICMP_ProcessICMPPacket(&((uint8_t*)InDataStart)[HeaderLengthBytes], + &((uint8_t*)OutDataStart)[sizeof(IP_Header_t)]); + break; + case PROTOCOL_TCP: + RetSize = TCP_ProcessTCPPacket(InDataStart, + &((uint8_t*)InDataStart)[HeaderLengthBytes], + &((uint8_t*)OutDataStart)[sizeof(IP_Header_t)]); + break; + case PROTOCOL_UDP: + RetSize = UDP_ProcessUDPPacket(InDataStart, + &((uint8_t*)InDataStart)[HeaderLengthBytes], + &((uint8_t*)OutDataStart)[sizeof(IP_Header_t)]); + break; + } + + /* Check to see if the protocol processing routine has filled out a response */ + if (RetSize > 0) + { + /* Fill out the response IP packet header */ + IPHeaderOUT->TotalLength = SwapEndian_16(sizeof(IP_Header_t) + RetSize); + IPHeaderOUT->TypeOfService = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->HeaderLength = (sizeof(IP_Header_t) / sizeof(uint32_t)); + IPHeaderOUT->Version = 4; + IPHeaderOUT->Flags = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->FragmentOffset = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->Identification = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->HeaderChecksum = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->Protocol = IPHeaderIN->Protocol; + IPHeaderOUT->TTL = DEFAULT_TTL; + IPHeaderOUT->SourceAddress = IPHeaderIN->DestinationAddress; + IPHeaderOUT->DestinationAddress = IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress; + + IPHeaderOUT->HeaderChecksum = Ethernet_Checksum16(IPHeaderOUT, sizeof(IP_Header_t)); + + /* Return the size of the response so far */ + return (sizeof(IP_Header_t) + RetSize); + } + + return RetSize; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/IP.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/IP.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..48f2c9086f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/IP.h @@ -0,0 +1,92 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for IP.c. + */ + +#ifndef _IP_H_ +#define _IP_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "EthernetProtocols.h" + #include "Ethernet.h" + #include "ProtocolDecoders.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Protocol IP address of the broadcast address. */ + #define BROADCAST_IP_ADDRESS {0xFF, 0xFF, 0xFF, 0xFF} + + /** Default Time To Live (TTL) value for sent packets, indicating the maximum allowable hops until their destination + * is reached. + */ + #define DEFAULT_TTL 128 + + /** Performs a comparison between two IP addresses, indicating if they are identical. + * + * \param[in] IP1 First IP address + * \param[in] IP2 Second IP address + * + * \return True if the addresses match, \c false otherwise + */ + #define IP_COMPARE(IP1, IP2) (memcmp(IP1, IP2, sizeof(IP_Address_t)) == 0) + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define of an IP packet header. */ + typedef struct + { + unsigned HeaderLength : 4; /**< Total length of the packet header, in 4-byte blocks */ + unsigned Version : 4; /**< IP protocol version */ + uint8_t TypeOfService; /**< Special service type identifier, indicating delay/throughput/reliability levels */ + uint16_t TotalLength; /**< Total length of the IP packet, in bytes */ + + uint16_t Identification; /**< Identification value for identifying fragmented packets */ + unsigned FragmentOffset : 13; /**< Offset of this IP fragment */ + unsigned Flags : 3; /**< Fragment flags, to indicate if a packet is fragmented */ + + uint8_t TTL; /**< Maximum allowable number of hops to reach the packet destination */ + uint8_t Protocol; /**< Encapsulated protocol type */ + uint16_t HeaderChecksum; /**< Ethernet checksum of the IP header */ + + IP_Address_t SourceAddress; /**< Source protocol IP address of the packet */ + IP_Address_t DestinationAddress; /**< Destination protocol IP address of the packet */ + } IP_Header_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + int16_t IP_ProcessIPPacket(void* InDataStart, + void* OutDataStart); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ProtocolDecoders.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ProtocolDecoders.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..90d678bf4b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ProtocolDecoders.c @@ -0,0 +1,276 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/* Protocol decoders for Ethernet, TCP, IP, ICMP and ARP. Each of these routines + accepts a header to the appropriate protocol and prints out pertinent information + on the packet through the serial port. + + To disable printing of a specific protocol, define the token NO_DECODE_{Protocol} + in the project makefile, and pass it to the compiler using the -D switch. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Protocol decoding routines, for the plain-text decoding of Ethernet frames for debugging purposes. + * Enabled protocol decoders will print incoming Ethernet frame contents through the USART in a human + * readable format. + * + * Note that the USART is a slow transmission medium, and will slow down packet processing considerably. + * Packet decoding routines can be disabled by defining NO_DECODE_{Protocol Name} in the project makefile + * and passing it to the compiler via the -D switch. + */ + +#include "ProtocolDecoders.h" + +/** Decodes an Ethernet frame header and prints its contents to through the USART in a human readable format. + * + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of an Ethernet frame header + */ +void DecodeEthernetFrameHeader(void* InDataStart) +{ + #if !defined(NO_DECODE_ETHERNET) + Ethernet_Frame_Header_t* FrameHeader = (Ethernet_Frame_Header_t*)InDataStart; + + printf_P(PSTR("\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" ETHERNET\r\n")); + + if (!(MAC_COMPARE(&FrameHeader->Destination, &ServerMACAddress)) && + !(MAC_COMPARE(&FrameHeader->Destination, &BroadcastMACAddress))) + { + printf_P(PSTR(" + NOT ADDRESSED TO DEVICE\r\n")); + return; + } + + printf_P(PSTR(" + MAC Source : %02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X\r\n"), FrameHeader->Source.Octets[0], + FrameHeader->Source.Octets[1], + FrameHeader->Source.Octets[2], + FrameHeader->Source.Octets[3], + FrameHeader->Source.Octets[4], + FrameHeader->Source.Octets[5]); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + MAC Dest: %02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X\r\n"), FrameHeader->Destination.Octets[0], + FrameHeader->Destination.Octets[1], + FrameHeader->Destination.Octets[2], + FrameHeader->Destination.Octets[3], + FrameHeader->Destination.Octets[4], + FrameHeader->Destination.Octets[5]); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Protocol: 0x%04x\r\n"), SwapEndian_16(FrameHeader->EtherType)); + #endif +} + +/** Decodes an ARP header and prints its contents to through the USART in a human readable format. + * + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of an ARP packet header + */ +void DecodeARPHeader(void* InDataStart) +{ + #if !defined(NO_DECODE_ARP) + ARP_Header_t* ARPHeader = (ARP_Header_t*)InDataStart; + + printf_P(PSTR(" \\\r\n ARP\r\n")); + + if (!(IP_COMPARE(&ARPHeader->TPA, &ServerIPAddress)) && + !(MAC_COMPARE(&ARPHeader->THA, &ServerMACAddress))) + { + printf_P(PSTR(" + NOT ADDRESSED TO DEVICE\r\n")); + return; + } + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Protocol: %x\r\n"), SwapEndian_16(ARPHeader->ProtocolType)); + printf_P(PSTR(" + Operation: %u\r\n"), SwapEndian_16(ARPHeader->Operation)); + + if (SwapEndian_16(ARPHeader->ProtocolType) == ETHERTYPE_IPV4) + { + printf_P(PSTR(" + SHA MAC: %02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X\r\n"), ARPHeader->SHA.Octets[0], + ARPHeader->SHA.Octets[1], + ARPHeader->SHA.Octets[2], + ARPHeader->SHA.Octets[3], + ARPHeader->SHA.Octets[4], + ARPHeader->SHA.Octets[5]); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + SPA IP: %u.%u.%u.%u\r\n"), ARPHeader->SPA.Octets[0], + ARPHeader->SPA.Octets[1], + ARPHeader->SPA.Octets[2], + ARPHeader->SPA.Octets[3]); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + THA MAC: %02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X\r\n"), ARPHeader->THA.Octets[0], + ARPHeader->THA.Octets[1], + ARPHeader->THA.Octets[2], + ARPHeader->THA.Octets[3], + ARPHeader->THA.Octets[4], + ARPHeader->THA.Octets[5]); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + TPA IP: %u.%u.%u.%u\r\n"), ARPHeader->TPA.Octets[0], + ARPHeader->TPA.Octets[1], + ARPHeader->TPA.Octets[2], + ARPHeader->TPA.Octets[3]); + } + #endif +} + +/** Decodes an IP header and prints its contents to through the USART in a human readable format. + * + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of an IP packet header + */ +void DecodeIPHeader(void* InDataStart) +{ + #if !defined(NO_DECODE_IP) + IP_Header_t* IPHeader = (IP_Header_t*)InDataStart; + + uint16_t HeaderLengthBytes = (IPHeader->HeaderLength * sizeof(uint32_t)); + + printf_P(PSTR(" \\\r\n IP\r\n")); + + if (!(IP_COMPARE(&IPHeader->DestinationAddress, &ServerIPAddress))) + { + printf_P(PSTR(" + NOT ADDRESSED TO DEVICE\r\n")); + return; + } + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Header Length: %u Bytes\r\n"), HeaderLengthBytes); + printf_P(PSTR(" + Packet Version: %u\r\n"), IPHeader->Version); + printf_P(PSTR(" + Total Length: %u\r\n"), SwapEndian_16(IPHeader->TotalLength)); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Protocol: %u\r\n"), IPHeader->Protocol); + printf_P(PSTR(" + TTL: %u\r\n"), IPHeader->TTL); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + IP Src: %u.%u.%u.%u\r\n"), IPHeader->SourceAddress.Octets[0], + IPHeader->SourceAddress.Octets[1], + IPHeader->SourceAddress.Octets[2], + IPHeader->SourceAddress.Octets[3]); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + IP Dst: %u.%u.%u.%u\r\n"), IPHeader->DestinationAddress.Octets[0], + IPHeader->DestinationAddress.Octets[1], + IPHeader->DestinationAddress.Octets[2], + IPHeader->DestinationAddress.Octets[3]); + #endif +} + +/** Decodes an ICMP header and prints its contents to through the USART in a human readable format. + * + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of an ICMP packet header + */ +void DecodeICMPHeader(void* InDataStart) +{ + #if !defined(NO_DECODE_ICMP) + ICMP_Header_t* ICMPHeader = (ICMP_Header_t*)InDataStart; + + printf_P(PSTR(" \\\r\n ICMP\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Type: %u\r\n"), ICMPHeader->Type); + printf_P(PSTR(" + Code: %u\r\n"), ICMPHeader->Code); + #endif +} + +/** Decodes a TCP header and prints its contents to through the USART in a human readable format. + * + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of a TCP packet header + */ +void DecodeTCPHeader(void* InDataStart) +{ + #if !defined(NO_DECODE_TCP) + TCP_Header_t* TCPHeader = (TCP_Header_t*)InDataStart; + + uint16_t HeaderLengthBytes = (TCPHeader->DataOffset * sizeof(uint32_t)); + + printf_P(PSTR(" \\\r\n TCP\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Header Length: %u Bytes\r\n"), HeaderLengthBytes); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Source Port: %u\r\n"), SwapEndian_16(TCPHeader->SourcePort)); + printf_P(PSTR(" + Destination Port: %u\r\n"), SwapEndian_16(TCPHeader->DestinationPort)); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Sequence Number: %lu\r\n"), SwapEndian_32(TCPHeader->SequenceNumber)); + printf_P(PSTR(" + Acknowledgment Number: %lu\r\n"), SwapEndian_32(TCPHeader->AcknowledgmentNumber)); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Flags: 0x%02X\r\n"), TCPHeader->Flags); + + if (TCP_GetPortState(TCPHeader->DestinationPort) == TCP_Port_Closed) + printf_P(PSTR(" + NOT LISTENING ON DESTINATION PORT\r\n")); + #endif +} + +/** Decodes an UDP header and prints its contents to through the USART in a human readable format. + * + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of a UDP packet header + */ +void DecodeUDPHeader(void* InDataStart) +{ + #if !defined(NO_DECODE_UDP) + UDP_Header_t* UDPHeader = (UDP_Header_t*)InDataStart; + + printf_P(PSTR(" \\\r\n UDP\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Source Port: %u\r\n"), SwapEndian_16(UDPHeader->SourcePort)); + printf_P(PSTR(" + Destination Port: %u\r\n"), SwapEndian_16(UDPHeader->DestinationPort)); + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Data Length: %d\r\n"), SwapEndian_16(UDPHeader->Length)); + #endif +} + +/** Decodes an DHCP header and prints its contents to through the USART in a human readable format. + * + * \param[in] InDataStart Pointer to the start of a DHCP packet header + */ +void DecodeDHCPHeader(void* InDataStart) +{ + #if !defined(NO_DECODE_DHCP) + uint8_t* DHCPOptions = ((uint8_t*)InDataStart + sizeof(DHCP_Header_t)); + + printf_P(PSTR(" \\\r\n DHCP\r\n")); + + while (DHCPOptions[0] != DHCP_OPTION_END) + { + if (DHCPOptions[0] == DHCP_OPTION_MESSAGETYPE) + { + switch (DHCPOptions[2]) + { + case DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_DISCOVER: + printf_P(PSTR(" + DISCOVER\r\n")); + break; + case DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_REQUEST: + printf_P(PSTR(" + REQUEST\r\n")); + break; + case DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_RELEASE: + printf_P(PSTR(" + RELEASE\r\n")); + break; + case DHCP_MESSAGETYPE_DECLINE: + printf_P(PSTR(" + DECLINE\r\n")); + break; + } + } + + DHCPOptions += ((DHCPOptions[0] == DHCP_OPTION_PAD) ? 1 : (DHCPOptions[1] + 2)); + } + #endif +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ProtocolDecoders.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ProtocolDecoders.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..77a50f02f4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/ProtocolDecoders.h @@ -0,0 +1,60 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ProtocolDecoders.c. + */ + +#ifndef _PROTOCOL_DECODERS_H_ +#define _PROTOCOL_DECODERS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + + #include "EthernetProtocols.h" + #include "Ethernet.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void DecodeEthernetFrameHeader(void* InDataStart); + void DecodeARPHeader(void* InDataStart); + void DecodeIPHeader(void* InDataStart); + void DecodeICMPHeader(void* InDataStart); + void DecodeTCPHeader(void* InDataStart); + void DecodeUDPHeader(void* InDataStart); + void DecodeDHCPHeader(void* InDataStart); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/RNDIS.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/RNDIS.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..00052ed39d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/RNDIS.c @@ -0,0 +1,394 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * RNDIS command handler functions. This handles RNDIS commands according to + * the Microsoft RNDIS specification, creating a USB Ethernet network adapter. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_RNDIS_C +#include "RNDIS.h" + +/** Physical MAC address of the network adapter, which becomes the MAC address of the host for packets sent to the adapter. */ +static const MAC_Address_t PROGMEM AdapterMACAddress = {ADAPTER_MAC_ADDRESS}; + +/** Vendor description of the adapter. This is overridden by the INF file required to install the appropriate RNDIS drivers for + * the device, but may still be used by the OS in some circumstances. + */ +static const char PROGMEM AdapterVendorDescription[] = "LUFA RNDIS Adapter"; + +/** List of RNDIS OID commands supported by this adapter. */ +static const uint32_t PROGMEM AdapterSupportedOIDList[] = + { + OID_GEN_SUPPORTED_LIST, + OID_GEN_PHYSICAL_MEDIUM, + OID_GEN_HARDWARE_STATUS, + OID_GEN_MEDIA_SUPPORTED, + OID_GEN_MEDIA_IN_USE, + OID_GEN_MAXIMUM_FRAME_SIZE, + OID_GEN_MAXIMUM_TOTAL_SIZE, + OID_GEN_LINK_SPEED, + OID_GEN_TRANSMIT_BLOCK_SIZE, + OID_GEN_RECEIVE_BLOCK_SIZE, + OID_GEN_VENDOR_ID, + OID_GEN_VENDOR_DESCRIPTION, + OID_GEN_CURRENT_PACKET_FILTER, + OID_GEN_MAXIMUM_TOTAL_SIZE, + OID_GEN_MEDIA_CONNECT_STATUS, + OID_GEN_XMIT_OK, + OID_GEN_RCV_OK, + OID_GEN_XMIT_ERROR, + OID_GEN_RCV_ERROR, + OID_GEN_RCV_NO_BUFFER, + OID_802_3_PERMANENT_ADDRESS, + OID_802_3_CURRENT_ADDRESS, + OID_802_3_MULTICAST_LIST, + OID_802_3_MAXIMUM_LIST_SIZE, + OID_802_3_RCV_ERROR_ALIGNMENT, + OID_802_3_XMIT_ONE_COLLISION, + OID_802_3_XMIT_MORE_COLLISIONS, + }; + +/** Buffer for RNDIS messages (as distinct from Ethernet frames sent through the adapter. This must be big enough to hold the entire + * Supported OID list, plus the response header. The buffer is half-duplex, and is written to as it is read to save on SRAM - for this + * reason, care must be taken when constructing RNDIS responses that unread data is not overwritten when writing in responses. + */ +uint8_t RNDISMessageBuffer[sizeof(AdapterSupportedOIDList) + sizeof(RNDIS_Query_Complete_t)]; + +/** Pointer to the RNDIS message header at the top of the RNDIS message buffer, for convenience. */ +RNDIS_Message_Header_t* MessageHeader = (RNDIS_Message_Header_t*)&RNDISMessageBuffer; + +/** Indicates if a RNDIS message response is ready to be sent back to the host. */ +bool ResponseReady = false; + +/** Current RNDIS adapter state, a value from the \c RNDIS_States_t enum. */ +uint8_t CurrRNDISState = RNDIS_Uninitialized; + +/** Current Ethernet packet filter mask. This is non-zero when the adapter is initialized, or zero when disabled. */ +uint32_t CurrPacketFilter = 0; + + +/** Processes the RNDIS message received by the host and stored in the RNDISMessageBuffer global buffer. If a response is + * created, the ResponseReady global is updated so that the response is written back to the host upon request. + */ +void ProcessRNDISControlMessage(void) +{ + /* Note: Only a single buffer is used for both the received message and its response to save SRAM. Because of + this, response bytes should be filled in order so that they do not clobber unread data in the buffer. */ + + switch (MessageHeader->MessageType) + { + case REMOTE_NDIS_INITIALIZE_MSG: + /* Initialize the adapter - return information about the supported RNDIS version and buffer sizes */ + + ResponseReady = true; + + RNDIS_Initialize_Message_t* INITIALIZE_Message = (RNDIS_Initialize_Message_t*)&RNDISMessageBuffer; + RNDIS_Initialize_Complete_t* INITIALIZE_Response = (RNDIS_Initialize_Complete_t*)&RNDISMessageBuffer; + + INITIALIZE_Response->MessageType = REMOTE_NDIS_INITIALIZE_CMPLT; + INITIALIZE_Response->MessageLength = sizeof(RNDIS_Initialize_Complete_t); + INITIALIZE_Response->RequestId = INITIALIZE_Message->RequestId; + INITIALIZE_Response->Status = REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_SUCCESS; + + INITIALIZE_Response->MajorVersion = REMOTE_NDIS_VERSION_MAJOR; + INITIALIZE_Response->MinorVersion = REMOTE_NDIS_VERSION_MINOR; + INITIALIZE_Response->DeviceFlags = REMOTE_NDIS_DF_CONNECTIONLESS; + INITIALIZE_Response->Medium = REMOTE_NDIS_MEDIUM_802_3; + INITIALIZE_Response->MaxPacketsPerTransfer = 1; + INITIALIZE_Response->MaxTransferSize = (sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t) + ETHERNET_FRAME_SIZE_MAX); + INITIALIZE_Response->PacketAlignmentFactor = 0; + INITIALIZE_Response->AFListOffset = 0; + INITIALIZE_Response->AFListSize = 0; + + CurrRNDISState = RNDIS_Initialized; + + break; + case REMOTE_NDIS_HALT_MSG: + /* Halt the adapter, reset the adapter state - note that no response should be returned when completed */ + + ResponseReady = false; + MessageHeader->MessageLength = 0; + + CurrRNDISState = RNDIS_Uninitialized; + + break; + case REMOTE_NDIS_QUERY_MSG: + /* Request for information about a parameter about the adapter, specified as an OID token */ + + ResponseReady = true; + + RNDIS_Query_Message_t* QUERY_Message = (RNDIS_Query_Message_t*)&RNDISMessageBuffer; + RNDIS_Query_Complete_t* QUERY_Response = (RNDIS_Query_Complete_t*)&RNDISMessageBuffer; + uint32_t Query_Oid = QUERY_Message->Oid; + + void* QueryData = &RNDISMessageBuffer[sizeof(RNDIS_Message_Header_t) + + QUERY_Message->InformationBufferOffset]; + void* ResponseData = &RNDISMessageBuffer[sizeof(RNDIS_Query_Complete_t)]; + uint16_t ResponseSize; + + QUERY_Response->MessageType = REMOTE_NDIS_QUERY_CMPLT; + QUERY_Response->MessageLength = sizeof(RNDIS_Query_Complete_t); + + if (ProcessNDISQuery(Query_Oid, QueryData, QUERY_Message->InformationBufferLength, + ResponseData, &ResponseSize)) + { + QUERY_Response->Status = REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_SUCCESS; + QUERY_Response->MessageLength += ResponseSize; + + QUERY_Response->InformationBufferLength = ResponseSize; + QUERY_Response->InformationBufferOffset = (sizeof(RNDIS_Query_Complete_t) - sizeof(RNDIS_Message_Header_t)); + } + else + { + QUERY_Response->Status = REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_NOT_SUPPORTED; + + QUERY_Response->InformationBufferLength = 0; + QUERY_Response->InformationBufferOffset = 0; + } + + break; + case REMOTE_NDIS_SET_MSG: + /* Request to set a parameter of the adapter, specified as an OID token */ + + ResponseReady = true; + + RNDIS_Set_Message_t* SET_Message = (RNDIS_Set_Message_t*)&RNDISMessageBuffer; + RNDIS_Set_Complete_t* SET_Response = (RNDIS_Set_Complete_t*)&RNDISMessageBuffer; + uint32_t SET_Oid = SET_Message->Oid; + + SET_Response->MessageType = REMOTE_NDIS_SET_CMPLT; + SET_Response->MessageLength = sizeof(RNDIS_Set_Complete_t); + SET_Response->RequestId = SET_Message->RequestId; + + void* SetData = &RNDISMessageBuffer[sizeof(RNDIS_Message_Header_t) + + SET_Message->InformationBufferOffset]; + + if (ProcessNDISSet(SET_Oid, SetData, SET_Message->InformationBufferLength)) + SET_Response->Status = REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_SUCCESS; + else + SET_Response->Status = REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_NOT_SUPPORTED; + + break; + case REMOTE_NDIS_RESET_MSG: + /* Soft reset the adapter */ + + ResponseReady = true; + + RNDIS_Reset_Complete_t* RESET_Response = (RNDIS_Reset_Complete_t*)&RNDISMessageBuffer; + + RESET_Response->MessageType = REMOTE_NDIS_RESET_CMPLT; + RESET_Response->MessageLength = sizeof(RNDIS_Reset_Complete_t); + RESET_Response->Status = REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_SUCCESS; + RESET_Response->AddressingReset = 0; + + break; + case REMOTE_NDIS_KEEPALIVE_MSG: + /* Keep alive message sent to the adapter every 5 seconds when idle to ensure it is still responding */ + + ResponseReady = true; + + RNDIS_KeepAlive_Message_t* KEEPALIVE_Message = (RNDIS_KeepAlive_Message_t*)&RNDISMessageBuffer; + RNDIS_KeepAlive_Complete_t* KEEPALIVE_Response = (RNDIS_KeepAlive_Complete_t*)&RNDISMessageBuffer; + + KEEPALIVE_Response->MessageType = REMOTE_NDIS_KEEPALIVE_CMPLT; + KEEPALIVE_Response->MessageLength = sizeof(RNDIS_KeepAlive_Complete_t); + KEEPALIVE_Response->RequestId = KEEPALIVE_Message->RequestId; + KEEPALIVE_Response->Status = REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_SUCCESS; + + break; + } +} + +/** Processes RNDIS query commands, retrieving information from the adapter and reporting it back to the host. The requested + * parameter is given as an OID value. + * + * \param[in] OId OId value of the parameter being queried + * \param[in] QueryData Pointer to any extra query data being sent by the host to the device inside the RNDIS message buffer + * \param[in] QuerySize Size in bytes of the extra query data being sent by the host + * \param[out] ResponseData Pointer to the start of the query response inside the RNDIS message buffer + * \param[out] ResponseSize Pointer to the size in bytes of the response data being sent to the host + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the query was handled, \c false otherwise + */ +static bool ProcessNDISQuery(const uint32_t OId, void* QueryData, uint16_t QuerySize, + void* ResponseData, uint16_t* ResponseSize) +{ + /* Handler for REMOTE_NDIS_QUERY_MSG messages */ + + switch (OId) + { + case OID_GEN_SUPPORTED_LIST: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(AdapterSupportedOIDList); + + /* Copy the list of supported NDIS OID tokens to the response buffer */ + memcpy_P(ResponseData, AdapterSupportedOIDList, sizeof(AdapterSupportedOIDList)); + + return true; + case OID_GEN_PHYSICAL_MEDIUM: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + /* Indicate that the device is a true ethernet link */ + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = 0; + + return true; + case OID_GEN_HARDWARE_STATUS: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + /* Always indicate hardware ready */ + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = NDIS_HardwareStatus_Ready; + + return true; + case OID_GEN_MEDIA_SUPPORTED: + case OID_GEN_MEDIA_IN_USE: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + /* Indicate 802.3 (Ethernet) supported by the adapter */ + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = REMOTE_NDIS_MEDIUM_802_3; + + return true; + case OID_GEN_VENDOR_ID: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + /* Vendor ID 0x0xFFFFFF is reserved for vendors who have not purchased a NDIS VID */ + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = 0x00FFFFFF; + + return true; + case OID_GEN_MAXIMUM_FRAME_SIZE: + case OID_GEN_TRANSMIT_BLOCK_SIZE: + case OID_GEN_RECEIVE_BLOCK_SIZE: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + /* Indicate that the maximum frame size is the size of the ethernet frame buffer */ + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = ETHERNET_FRAME_SIZE_MAX; + + return true; + case OID_GEN_VENDOR_DESCRIPTION: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(AdapterVendorDescription); + + /* Copy vendor description string to the response buffer */ + memcpy_P(ResponseData, AdapterVendorDescription, sizeof(AdapterVendorDescription)); + + return true; + case OID_GEN_MEDIA_CONNECT_STATUS: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + /* Always indicate that the adapter is connected to a network */ + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = REMOTE_NDIS_MEDIA_STATE_CONNECTED; + + return true; + case OID_GEN_LINK_SPEED: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + /* Indicate 10Mb/s link speed */ + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = 100000; + + return true; + case OID_802_3_PERMANENT_ADDRESS: + case OID_802_3_CURRENT_ADDRESS: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(MAC_Address_t); + + /* Copy over the fixed adapter MAC to the response buffer */ + memcpy_P(ResponseData, &AdapterMACAddress, sizeof(MAC_Address_t)); + + return true; + case OID_802_3_MAXIMUM_LIST_SIZE: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + /* Indicate only one multicast address supported */ + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = 1; + + return true; + case OID_GEN_CURRENT_PACKET_FILTER: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + /* Indicate the current packet filter mask */ + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = CurrPacketFilter; + + return true; + case OID_GEN_XMIT_OK: + case OID_GEN_RCV_OK: + case OID_GEN_XMIT_ERROR: + case OID_GEN_RCV_ERROR: + case OID_GEN_RCV_NO_BUFFER: + case OID_802_3_RCV_ERROR_ALIGNMENT: + case OID_802_3_XMIT_ONE_COLLISION: + case OID_802_3_XMIT_MORE_COLLISIONS: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + /* Unused statistic OIDs - always return 0 for each */ + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = 0; + + return true; + case OID_GEN_MAXIMUM_TOTAL_SIZE: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + /* Indicate maximum overall buffer (Ethernet frame and RNDIS header) the adapter can handle */ + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = (sizeof(RNDISMessageBuffer) + ETHERNET_FRAME_SIZE_MAX); + + return true; + default: + return false; + } +} + +/** Processes RNDIS set commands, setting adapter parameters to values given by the host. The requested parameter is given + * as an OID value. + * + * \param[in] OId OId value of the parameter being set + * \param[in] SetData Pointer to the parameter value in the RNDIS message buffer + * \param[in] SetSize Size in bytes of the parameter value being sent by the host + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the set was handled, \c false otherwise + */ +static bool ProcessNDISSet(uint32_t OId, void* SetData, uint16_t SetSize) +{ + /* Handler for REMOTE_NDIS_SET_MSG messages */ + + switch (OId) + { + case OID_GEN_CURRENT_PACKET_FILTER: + /* Save the packet filter mask in case the host queries it again later */ + CurrPacketFilter = *((uint32_t*)SetData); + + /* Set the RNDIS state to initialized if the packet filter is non-zero */ + CurrRNDISState = ((CurrPacketFilter) ? RNDIS_Data_Initialized : RNDIS_Initialized); + + return true; + case OID_802_3_MULTICAST_LIST: + /* Do nothing - throw away the value from the host as it is unused */ + + return true; + default: + return false; + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/RNDIS.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/RNDIS.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bea97f79df --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/RNDIS.h @@ -0,0 +1,67 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for RNDIS.c. + */ + +#ifndef _RNDIS_H_ +#define _RNDIS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include "../RNDISEthernet.h" + #include "Ethernet.h" + + /* External Variables: */ + extern uint8_t RNDISMessageBuffer[]; + extern RNDIS_Message_Header_t* MessageHeader; + extern bool ResponseReady; + extern uint8_t CurrRNDISState; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void ProcessRNDISControlMessage(void); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_RNDIS_C) + static bool ProcessNDISQuery(const uint32_t OId, + void* QueryData, + uint16_t QuerySize, + void* ResponseData, + uint16_t* ResponseSize); + static bool ProcessNDISSet(const uint32_t OId, + void* SetData, + uint16_t SetSize); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/TCP.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/TCP.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a6f1f6adfc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/TCP.c @@ -0,0 +1,631 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Transmission Control Protocol (TCP) packet handling routines. This protocol handles the reliable in-order transmission + * and reception of packets to and from devices on a network, to "ports" on the device. It is used in situations where data + * delivery must be reliable and correct, e.g. HTTP, TELNET and most other non-streaming protocols. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_TCP_C +#include "TCP.h" + +/** Port state table array. This contains the current status of TCP ports in the device. To save on space, only open ports are + * stored - closed ports may be overwritten at any time, and the system will assume any ports not present in the array are closed. This + * allows for MAX_OPEN_TCP_PORTS to be less than the number of ports used by the application if desired. + */ +TCP_PortState_t PortStateTable[MAX_OPEN_TCP_PORTS]; + +/** Connection state table array. This contains the current status of TCP connections in the device. To save on space, only active + * (non-closed) connections are stored - closed connections may be overwritten at any time, and the system will assume any connections + * not present in the array are closed. + */ +TCP_ConnectionState_t ConnectionStateTable[MAX_TCP_CONNECTIONS]; + + +/** Task to handle the calling of each registered application's callback function, to process and generate TCP packets at the application + * level. If an application produces a response, this task constructs the appropriate Ethernet frame and places it into the Ethernet OUT + * buffer for later transmission. + */ +void TCP_Task(void) +{ + /* Run each application in sequence, to process incoming and generate outgoing packets */ + for (uint8_t CSTableEntry = 0; CSTableEntry < MAX_TCP_CONNECTIONS; CSTableEntry++) + { + /* Find the corresponding port entry in the port table */ + for (uint8_t PTableEntry = 0; PTableEntry < MAX_OPEN_TCP_PORTS; PTableEntry++) + { + /* Run the application handler for the port */ + if ((PortStateTable[PTableEntry].Port == ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Port) && + (PortStateTable[PTableEntry].State == TCP_Port_Open)) + { + PortStateTable[PTableEntry].ApplicationHandler(&ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry], + &ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info.Buffer); + } + } + } + + /* Bail out early if there is already a frame waiting to be sent in the Ethernet OUT buffer */ + if (FrameOUT.FrameLength) + return; + + /* Send response packets from each application as the TCP packet buffers are filled by the applications */ + for (uint8_t CSTableEntry = 0; CSTableEntry < MAX_TCP_CONNECTIONS; CSTableEntry++) + { + /* For each completely received packet, pass it along to the listening application */ + if ((ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info.Buffer.Direction == TCP_PACKETDIR_OUT) && + (ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info.Buffer.Ready)) + { + Ethernet_Frame_Header_t* FrameOUTHeader = (Ethernet_Frame_Header_t*)&FrameOUT.FrameData; + IP_Header_t* IPHeaderOUT = (IP_Header_t*)&FrameOUT.FrameData[sizeof(Ethernet_Frame_Header_t)]; + TCP_Header_t* TCPHeaderOUT = (TCP_Header_t*)&FrameOUT.FrameData[sizeof(Ethernet_Frame_Header_t) + + sizeof(IP_Header_t)]; + void* TCPDataOUT = &FrameOUT.FrameData[sizeof(Ethernet_Frame_Header_t) + + sizeof(IP_Header_t) + + sizeof(TCP_Header_t)]; + + uint16_t PacketSize = ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info.Buffer.Length; + + /* Fill out the TCP data */ + TCPHeaderOUT->SourcePort = ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Port; + TCPHeaderOUT->DestinationPort = ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemotePort; + TCPHeaderOUT->SequenceNumber = SwapEndian_32(ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info.SequenceNumberOut); + TCPHeaderOUT->AcknowledgmentNumber = SwapEndian_32(ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info.SequenceNumberIn); + TCPHeaderOUT->DataOffset = (sizeof(TCP_Header_t) / sizeof(uint32_t)); + TCPHeaderOUT->WindowSize = SwapEndian_16(TCP_WINDOW_SIZE); + + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = TCP_FLAG_ACK; + TCPHeaderOUT->UrgentPointer = 0; + TCPHeaderOUT->Checksum = 0; + TCPHeaderOUT->Reserved = 0; + + memcpy(TCPDataOUT, ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info.Buffer.Data, PacketSize); + + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info.SequenceNumberOut += PacketSize; + + TCPHeaderOUT->Checksum = TCP_Checksum16(TCPHeaderOUT, &ServerIPAddress, + &ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemoteAddress, + (sizeof(TCP_Header_t) + PacketSize)); + + PacketSize += sizeof(TCP_Header_t); + + /* Fill out the response IP header */ + IPHeaderOUT->TotalLength = SwapEndian_16(sizeof(IP_Header_t) + PacketSize); + IPHeaderOUT->TypeOfService = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->HeaderLength = (sizeof(IP_Header_t) / sizeof(uint32_t)); + IPHeaderOUT->Version = 4; + IPHeaderOUT->Flags = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->FragmentOffset = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->Identification = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->HeaderChecksum = 0; + IPHeaderOUT->Protocol = PROTOCOL_TCP; + IPHeaderOUT->TTL = DEFAULT_TTL; + IPHeaderOUT->SourceAddress = ServerIPAddress; + IPHeaderOUT->DestinationAddress = ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemoteAddress; + + IPHeaderOUT->HeaderChecksum = Ethernet_Checksum16(IPHeaderOUT, sizeof(IP_Header_t)); + + PacketSize += sizeof(IP_Header_t); + + /* Fill out the response Ethernet frame header */ + FrameOUTHeader->Source = ServerMACAddress; + FrameOUTHeader->Destination = (MAC_Address_t){{0x02, 0x00, 0x02, 0x00, 0x02, 0x00}}; + FrameOUTHeader->EtherType = SwapEndian_16(ETHERTYPE_IPV4); + + PacketSize += sizeof(Ethernet_Frame_Header_t); + + /* Set the response length in the buffer and indicate that a response is ready to be sent */ + FrameOUT.FrameLength = PacketSize; + + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info.Buffer.Ready = false; + + break; + } + } +} + +/** Initializes the TCP protocol handler, clearing the port and connection state tables. This must be called before TCP packets are + * processed. + */ +void TCP_Init(void) +{ + /* Initialize the port state table with all CLOSED entries */ + for (uint8_t PTableEntry = 0; PTableEntry < MAX_OPEN_TCP_PORTS; PTableEntry++) + PortStateTable[PTableEntry].State = TCP_Port_Closed; + + /* Initialize the connection table with all CLOSED entries */ + for (uint8_t CSTableEntry = 0; CSTableEntry < MAX_TCP_CONNECTIONS; CSTableEntry++) + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].State = TCP_Connection_Closed; +} + +/** Sets the state and callback handler of the given port, specified in big endian to the given state. + * + * \param[in] Port Port whose state and callback function to set, specified in big endian + * \param[in] State New state of the port, a value from the \ref TCP_PortStates_t enum + * \param[in] Handler Application callback handler for the port + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the port state was set, \c false otherwise (no more space in the port state table) + */ +bool TCP_SetPortState(const uint16_t Port, + const uint8_t State, + void (*Handler)(TCP_ConnectionState_t*, TCP_ConnectionBuffer_t*)) +{ + /* Note, Port number should be specified in BIG endian to simplify network code */ + + /* Check to see if the port entry is already in the port state table */ + for (uint8_t PTableEntry = 0; PTableEntry < MAX_OPEN_TCP_PORTS; PTableEntry++) + { + /* Find existing entry for the port in the table, update it if found */ + if (PortStateTable[PTableEntry].Port == Port) + { + PortStateTable[PTableEntry].State = State; + PortStateTable[PTableEntry].ApplicationHandler = Handler; + return true; + } + } + + /* Check if trying to open the port -- if so we need to find an unused (closed) entry and replace it */ + if (State == TCP_Port_Open) + { + for (uint8_t PTableEntry = 0; PTableEntry < MAX_OPEN_TCP_PORTS; PTableEntry++) + { + /* Find a closed port entry in the table, change it to the given port and state */ + if (PortStateTable[PTableEntry].State == TCP_Port_Closed) + { + PortStateTable[PTableEntry].Port = Port; + PortStateTable[PTableEntry].State = State; + PortStateTable[PTableEntry].ApplicationHandler = Handler; + return true; + } + } + + /* Port not in table and no room to add it, return failure */ + return false; + } + else + { + /* Port not in table but trying to close it, so operation successful */ + return true; + } +} + +/** Retrieves the current state of a given TCP port, specified in big endian. + * + * \param[in] Port TCP port whose state is to be retrieved, given in big-endian + * + * \return A value from the \ref TCP_PortStates_t enum + */ +uint8_t TCP_GetPortState(const uint16_t Port) +{ + /* Note, Port number should be specified in BIG endian to simplify network code */ + + for (uint8_t PTableEntry = 0; PTableEntry < MAX_OPEN_TCP_PORTS; PTableEntry++) + { + /* Find existing entry for the port in the table, return the port status if found */ + if (PortStateTable[PTableEntry].Port == Port) + return PortStateTable[PTableEntry].State; + } + + /* Port not in table, assume closed */ + return TCP_Port_Closed; +} + +/** Sets the connection state of the given port, remote address and remote port to the given TCP connection state. If the + * connection exists in the connection state table it is updated, otherwise it is created if possible. + * + * \param[in] Port TCP port of the connection on the device, specified in big endian + * \param[in] RemoteAddress Remote protocol IP address of the connected device + * \param[in] RemotePort TCP port of the remote device in the connection, specified in big endian + * \param[in] State TCP connection state, a value from the \ref TCP_ConnectionStates_t enum + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the connection was updated or created, \c false otherwise (no more space in the connection state table) + */ +bool TCP_SetConnectionState(const uint16_t Port, + const IP_Address_t* RemoteAddress, + const uint16_t RemotePort, + const uint8_t State) +{ + /* Note, Port number should be specified in BIG endian to simplify network code */ + + for (uint8_t CSTableEntry = 0; CSTableEntry < MAX_TCP_CONNECTIONS; CSTableEntry++) + { + /* Find port entry in the table */ + if ((ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Port == Port) && + IP_COMPARE(&ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemoteAddress, RemoteAddress) && + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemotePort == RemotePort) + { + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].State = State; + return true; + } + } + + for (uint8_t CSTableEntry = 0; CSTableEntry < MAX_TCP_CONNECTIONS; CSTableEntry++) + { + /* Find empty entry in the table */ + if (ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].State == TCP_Connection_Closed) + { + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Port = Port; + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemoteAddress = *RemoteAddress; + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemotePort = RemotePort; + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].State = State; + return true; + } + } + + return false; +} + +/** Retrieves the current state of a given TCP connection to a host. + * + * \param[in] Port TCP port on the device in the connection, specified in big endian + * \param[in] RemoteAddress Remote protocol IP address of the connected host + * \param[in] RemotePort Remote TCP port of the connected host, specified in big endian + * + * \return A value from the \ref TCP_ConnectionStates_t enum + */ +uint8_t TCP_GetConnectionState(const uint16_t Port, + const IP_Address_t* RemoteAddress, + const uint16_t RemotePort) +{ + /* Note, Port number should be specified in BIG endian to simplify network code */ + + for (uint8_t CSTableEntry = 0; CSTableEntry < MAX_TCP_CONNECTIONS; CSTableEntry++) + { + /* Find port entry in the table */ + if ((ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Port == Port) && + IP_COMPARE(&ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemoteAddress, RemoteAddress) && + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemotePort == RemotePort) + + { + return ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].State; + } + } + + return TCP_Connection_Closed; +} + +/** Retrieves the connection info structure of a given connection to a host. + * + * \param[in] Port TCP port on the device in the connection, specified in big endian + * \param[in] RemoteAddress Remote protocol IP address of the connected host + * \param[in] RemotePort Remote TCP port of the connected host, specified in big endian + * + * \return ConnectionInfo structure of the connection if found, NULL otherwise + */ +TCP_ConnectionInfo_t* TCP_GetConnectionInfo(const uint16_t Port, + const IP_Address_t* RemoteAddress, + const uint16_t RemotePort) +{ + /* Note, Port number should be specified in BIG endian to simplify network code */ + + for (uint8_t CSTableEntry = 0; CSTableEntry < MAX_TCP_CONNECTIONS; CSTableEntry++) + { + /* Find port entry in the table */ + if ((ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Port == Port) && + IP_COMPARE(&ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemoteAddress, RemoteAddress) && + ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].RemotePort == RemotePort) + { + return &ConnectionStateTable[CSTableEntry].Info; + } + } + + return NULL; +} + +/** Processes a TCP packet inside an Ethernet frame, and writes the appropriate response + * to the output Ethernet frame if one is created by a application handler. + * + * \param[in] IPHeaderInStart Pointer to the start of the incoming packet's IP header + * \param[in] TCPHeaderInStart Pointer to the start of the incoming packet's TCP header + * \param[out] TCPHeaderOutStart Pointer to the start of the outgoing packet's TCP header + * + * \return The number of bytes written to the out Ethernet frame if any, NO_RESPONSE if no + * response was generated, NO_PROCESS if the packet processing was deferred until the + * next Ethernet packet handler iteration + */ +int16_t TCP_ProcessTCPPacket(void* IPHeaderInStart, + void* TCPHeaderInStart, + void* TCPHeaderOutStart) +{ + IP_Header_t* IPHeaderIN = (IP_Header_t*)IPHeaderInStart; + TCP_Header_t* TCPHeaderIN = (TCP_Header_t*)TCPHeaderInStart; + TCP_Header_t* TCPHeaderOUT = (TCP_Header_t*)TCPHeaderOutStart; + + TCP_ConnectionInfo_t* ConnectionInfo; + + DecodeTCPHeader(TCPHeaderInStart); + + bool PacketResponse = false; + + /* Check if the destination port is open and allows incoming connections */ + if (TCP_GetPortState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort) == TCP_Port_Open) + { + /* Detect SYN from host to start a connection */ + if (TCPHeaderIN->Flags & TCP_FLAG_SYN) + TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_Listen); + + /* Detect RST from host to abort existing connection */ + if (TCPHeaderIN->Flags & TCP_FLAG_RST) + { + if (TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_Closed)) + { + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = (TCP_FLAG_RST | TCP_FLAG_ACK); + PacketResponse = true; + } + } + else + { + /* Process the incoming TCP packet based on the current connection state for the sender and port */ + switch (TCP_GetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort)) + { + case TCP_Connection_Listen: + if (TCPHeaderIN->Flags == TCP_FLAG_SYN) + { + /* SYN connection starts a connection with a peer */ + if (TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_SYNReceived)) + { + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = (TCP_FLAG_SYN | TCP_FLAG_ACK); + + ConnectionInfo = TCP_GetConnectionInfo(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort); + + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberIn = (SwapEndian_32(TCPHeaderIN->SequenceNumber) + 1); + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberOut = 0; + ConnectionInfo->Buffer.InUse = false; + } + else + { + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = TCP_FLAG_RST; + } + + PacketResponse = true; + } + + break; + case TCP_Connection_SYNReceived: + if (TCPHeaderIN->Flags == TCP_FLAG_ACK) + { + /* ACK during the connection process completes the connection to a peer */ + + TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_Established); + + ConnectionInfo = TCP_GetConnectionInfo(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort); + + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberOut++; + } + + break; + case TCP_Connection_Established: + if (TCPHeaderIN->Flags == (TCP_FLAG_FIN | TCP_FLAG_ACK)) + { + /* FIN ACK when connected to a peer starts the finalization process */ + + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = (TCP_FLAG_FIN | TCP_FLAG_ACK); + PacketResponse = true; + + TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_CloseWait); + + ConnectionInfo = TCP_GetConnectionInfo(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort); + + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberIn++; + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberOut++; + } + else if ((TCPHeaderIN->Flags == TCP_FLAG_ACK) || (TCPHeaderIN->Flags == (TCP_FLAG_ACK | TCP_FLAG_PSH))) + { + ConnectionInfo = TCP_GetConnectionInfo(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort); + + /* Check if the buffer is currently in use either by a buffered data to send, or receive */ + if ((ConnectionInfo->Buffer.InUse == false) && (ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Ready == false)) + { + ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Direction = TCP_PACKETDIR_IN; + ConnectionInfo->Buffer.InUse = true; + ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Length = 0; + } + + /* Check if the buffer has been claimed by us to read in data from the peer */ + if ((ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Direction == TCP_PACKETDIR_IN) && + (ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Length != TCP_WINDOW_SIZE)) + { + uint16_t IPOffset = (IPHeaderIN->HeaderLength * sizeof(uint32_t)); + uint16_t TCPOffset = (TCPHeaderIN->DataOffset * sizeof(uint32_t)); + uint16_t DataLength = (SwapEndian_16(IPHeaderIN->TotalLength) - IPOffset - TCPOffset); + + /* Copy the packet data into the buffer */ + memcpy(&ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Data[ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Length], + &((uint8_t*)TCPHeaderInStart)[TCPOffset], + DataLength); + + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberIn += DataLength; + ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Length += DataLength; + + /* Check if the buffer is full or if the PSH flag is set, if so indicate buffer ready */ + if ((!(TCP_WINDOW_SIZE - ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Length)) || (TCPHeaderIN->Flags & TCP_FLAG_PSH)) + { + ConnectionInfo->Buffer.InUse = false; + ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Ready = true; + + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = TCP_FLAG_ACK; + PacketResponse = true; + } + } + else + { + /* Buffer is currently in use by the application, defer processing of the incoming packet */ + return NO_PROCESS; + } + } + + break; + case TCP_Connection_Closing: + ConnectionInfo = TCP_GetConnectionInfo(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort); + + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = (TCP_FLAG_ACK | TCP_FLAG_FIN); + PacketResponse = true; + + ConnectionInfo->Buffer.InUse = false; + + TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_FINWait1); + + break; + case TCP_Connection_FINWait1: + if (TCPHeaderIN->Flags == (TCP_FLAG_FIN | TCP_FLAG_ACK)) + { + ConnectionInfo = TCP_GetConnectionInfo(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort); + + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = TCP_FLAG_ACK; + PacketResponse = true; + + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberIn++; + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberOut++; + + TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_Closed); + } + else if (TCPHeaderIN->Flags == TCP_FLAG_ACK) + { + TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_FINWait2); + } + + break; + case TCP_Connection_FINWait2: + if (TCPHeaderIN->Flags == (TCP_FLAG_FIN | TCP_FLAG_ACK)) + { + ConnectionInfo = TCP_GetConnectionInfo(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort); + + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = TCP_FLAG_ACK; + PacketResponse = true; + + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberIn++; + ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberOut++; + + TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_Closed); + } + + break; + case TCP_Connection_CloseWait: + if (TCPHeaderIN->Flags == TCP_FLAG_ACK) + { + TCP_SetConnectionState(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort, TCP_Connection_Closed); + } + + break; + } + } + } + else + { + /* Port is not open, indicate via a RST/ACK response to the sender */ + TCPHeaderOUT->Flags = (TCP_FLAG_RST | TCP_FLAG_ACK); + PacketResponse = true; + } + + /* Check if we need to respond to the sent packet */ + if (PacketResponse) + { + ConnectionInfo = TCP_GetConnectionInfo(TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort, &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, + TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort); + + TCPHeaderOUT->SourcePort = TCPHeaderIN->DestinationPort; + TCPHeaderOUT->DestinationPort = TCPHeaderIN->SourcePort; + TCPHeaderOUT->SequenceNumber = SwapEndian_32(ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberOut); + TCPHeaderOUT->AcknowledgmentNumber = SwapEndian_32(ConnectionInfo->SequenceNumberIn); + TCPHeaderOUT->DataOffset = (sizeof(TCP_Header_t) / sizeof(uint32_t)); + + if (!(ConnectionInfo->Buffer.InUse)) + TCPHeaderOUT->WindowSize = SwapEndian_16(TCP_WINDOW_SIZE); + else + TCPHeaderOUT->WindowSize = SwapEndian_16(TCP_WINDOW_SIZE - ConnectionInfo->Buffer.Length); + + TCPHeaderOUT->UrgentPointer = 0; + TCPHeaderOUT->Checksum = 0; + TCPHeaderOUT->Reserved = 0; + + TCPHeaderOUT->Checksum = TCP_Checksum16(TCPHeaderOUT, &IPHeaderIN->DestinationAddress, + &IPHeaderIN->SourceAddress, sizeof(TCP_Header_t)); + + return sizeof(TCP_Header_t); + } + + return NO_RESPONSE; +} + +/** Calculates the appropriate TCP checksum, consisting of the addition of the one's compliment of each word, + * complimented. + * + * \param[in] TCPHeaderOutStart Pointer to the start of the packet's outgoing TCP header + * \param[in] SourceAddress Source protocol IP address of the outgoing IP header + * \param[in] DestinationAddress Destination protocol IP address of the outgoing IP header + * \param[in] TCPOutSize Size in bytes of the TCP data header and payload + * + * \return A 16-bit TCP checksum value + */ +static uint16_t TCP_Checksum16(void* TCPHeaderOutStart, + const IP_Address_t* SourceAddress, + const IP_Address_t* DestinationAddress, + uint16_t TCPOutSize) +{ + uint32_t Checksum = 0; + + /* TCP/IP checksums are the addition of the one's compliment of each word including the IP pseudo-header, + complimented */ + + Checksum += ((uint16_t*)SourceAddress)[0]; + Checksum += ((uint16_t*)SourceAddress)[1]; + Checksum += ((uint16_t*)DestinationAddress)[0]; + Checksum += ((uint16_t*)DestinationAddress)[1]; + Checksum += SwapEndian_16(PROTOCOL_TCP); + Checksum += SwapEndian_16(TCPOutSize); + + for (uint16_t CurrWord = 0; CurrWord < (TCPOutSize >> 1); CurrWord++) + Checksum += ((uint16_t*)TCPHeaderOutStart)[CurrWord]; + + if (TCPOutSize & 0x01) + Checksum += (((uint16_t*)TCPHeaderOutStart)[TCPOutSize >> 1] & 0x00FF); + + while (Checksum & 0xFFFF0000) + Checksum = ((Checksum & 0xFFFF) + (Checksum >> 16)); + + return ~Checksum; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/TCP.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/TCP.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ce8a9a2d0f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/TCP.h @@ -0,0 +1,260 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for TCP.c. + */ + +#ifndef _TCP_H_ +#define _TCP_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include "EthernetProtocols.h" + #include "Ethernet.h" + #include "ProtocolDecoders.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Maximum number of TCP ports which can be open at the one time. */ + #define MAX_OPEN_TCP_PORTS 1 + + /** Maximum number of TCP connections which can be sustained at the one time. */ + #define MAX_TCP_CONNECTIONS 3 + + /** TCP window size, giving the maximum number of bytes which can be buffered at the one time. */ + #define TCP_WINDOW_SIZE 512 + + /** Port number for HTTP transmissions. */ + #define TCP_PORT_HTTP SwapEndian_16(80) + + /** Data direction indicator for a TCP application buffer, indicating data from host-to-device. */ + #define TCP_PACKETDIR_IN false + + /** Data direction indicator for a TCP application buffer, indicating data from device-to-host. */ + #define TCP_PACKETDIR_OUT true + + /** Congestion Window Reduced TCP flag mask. */ + #define TCP_FLAG_CWR (1 << 7) + + /** Explicit Congestion Notification TCP flag mask. */ + #define TCP_FLAG_ECE (1 << 6) + + /** Urgent TCP flag mask. */ + #define TCP_FLAG_URG (1 << 5) + + /** Data Acknowledge TCP flag mask. */ + #define TCP_FLAG_ACK (1 << 4) + + /** Data Push TCP flag mask. */ + #define TCP_FLAG_PSH (1 << 3) + + /** Reset TCP flag mask. */ + #define TCP_FLAG_RST (1 << 2) + + /** Synchronize TCP flag mask. */ + #define TCP_FLAG_SYN (1 << 1) + + /** Connection Finalize TCP flag mask. */ + #define TCP_FLAG_FIN (1 << 0) + + /** Application macro: Determines if the given application buffer contains a packet received from the host + * + * \param[in] Buffer Application buffer to check + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the buffer contains a packet from the host, \c false otherwise + */ + #define TCP_APP_HAS_RECEIVED_PACKET(Buffer) (Buffer->Ready && (Buffer->Direction == TCP_PACKETDIR_IN)) + + /** Application macro: Indicates if the application buffer is currently locked by the application for device-to-host transfers. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Application buffer to check + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the buffer has been captured by the application for device-to-host transmissions, \c false otherwise + */ + #define TCP_APP_HAVE_CAPTURED_BUFFER(Buffer) (!(Buffer->Ready) && Buffer->InUse && \ + (Buffer->Direction == TCP_PACKETDIR_OUT)) + + /** Application macro: Indicates if the application can lock the buffer for multiple continued device-to-host transmissions. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Application buffer to check + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the buffer may be captured by the application for device-to-host transmissions, \c false otherwise + */ + #define TCP_APP_CAN_CAPTURE_BUFFER(Buffer) Buffer->InUse + + /** Application macro: Captures the application buffer, locking it for device-to-host transmissions only. This should be + * performed when the application needs to transmit several packets worth of data in succession with no interruptions from the host. + * + * \pre The application must check that the buffer can be locked first using TCP_APP_CAN_CAPTURE_BUFFER(). + * + * \param[in] Buffer Application buffer to lock + */ + #define TCP_APP_CAPTURE_BUFFER(Buffer) do { Buffer->Direction = TCP_PACKETDIR_OUT; Buffer->InUse = true; } while (0) + + /** Application macro: Releases a captured application buffer, allowing for host-to-device packets to be received. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Application buffer to release + */ + #define TCP_APP_RELEASE_BUFFER(Buffer) do { Buffer->InUse = false; } while (0) + + /** Application macro: Sends the contents of the given application buffer to the host. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Application buffer to send + * \param[in] Len Length of data contained in the buffer + */ + #define TCP_APP_SEND_BUFFER(Buffer, Len) do { Buffer->Direction = TCP_PACKETDIR_OUT; Buffer->Length = Len; Buffer->Ready = true; } while (0) + + /** Application macro: Clears the application buffer, ready for a packet to be written to it. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Application buffer to clear + */ + #define TCP_APP_CLEAR_BUFFER(Buffer) do { Buffer->Ready = false; Buffer->Length = 0; } while (0) + + /** Application macro: Closes an open connection to a host. + * + * \param[in] Connection Open TCP connection to close + */ + #define TCP_APP_CLOSECONNECTION(Connection) do { Connection->State = TCP_Connection_Closing; } while (0) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for possible TCP port states. */ + enum TCP_PortStates_t + { + TCP_Port_Closed = 0, /**< TCP port closed, no connections to a host may be made on this port. */ + TCP_Port_Open = 1, /**< TCP port open, connections to a host may be made on this port. */ + }; + + /** Enum for possible TCP connection states. */ + enum TCP_ConnectionStates_t + { + TCP_Connection_Listen = 0, /**< Listening for a connection from a host */ + TCP_Connection_SYNSent = 1, /**< Unused */ + TCP_Connection_SYNReceived = 2, /**< SYN received, waiting for ACK */ + TCP_Connection_Established = 3, /**< Connection established in both directions */ + TCP_Connection_FINWait1 = 4, /**< Closing, waiting for ACK */ + TCP_Connection_FINWait2 = 5, /**< Closing, waiting for FIN ACK */ + TCP_Connection_CloseWait = 6, /**< Closing, waiting for ACK */ + TCP_Connection_Closing = 7, /**< Unused */ + TCP_Connection_LastACK = 8, /**< Unused */ + TCP_Connection_TimeWait = 9, /**< Unused */ + TCP_Connection_Closed = 10, /**< Connection closed in both directions */ + }; + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a TCP connection buffer structure, including size, data and direction. */ + typedef struct + { + uint16_t Length; /**< Length of data in the TCP application buffer */ + uint8_t Data[TCP_WINDOW_SIZE]; /**< TCP application data buffer */ + bool Direction; /**< Buffer transmission direction, either TCP_PACKETDIR_IN or TCP_PACKETDIR_OUT */ + bool Ready; /**< If data from host, indicates buffer ready to be read, otherwise indicates + * buffer ready to be sent to the host + */ + bool InUse; /**< Indicates if the buffer is locked to to the current direction, and cannot be changed */ + } TCP_ConnectionBuffer_t; + + /** Type define for a TCP connection information structure. */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t SequenceNumberIn; /**< Current TCP sequence number for host-to-device */ + uint32_t SequenceNumberOut; /**< Current TCP sequence number for device-to-host */ + TCP_ConnectionBuffer_t Buffer; /**< Connection application data buffer */ + } TCP_ConnectionInfo_t; + + /** Type define for a complete TCP connection state. */ + typedef struct + { + uint16_t Port; /**< Connection port number on the device */ + uint16_t RemotePort; /**< Connection port number on the host */ + IP_Address_t RemoteAddress; /**< Connection protocol IP address of the host */ + TCP_ConnectionInfo_t Info; /**< Connection information, including application buffer */ + uint8_t State; /**< Current connection state, a value from the \ref TCP_ConnectionStates_t enum */ + } TCP_ConnectionState_t; + + /** Type define for a TCP port state. */ + typedef struct + { + uint16_t Port; /**< TCP port number on the device */ + uint8_t State; /**< Current port state, a value from the \ref TCP_PortStates_t enum */ + void (*ApplicationHandler) (TCP_ConnectionState_t* ConnectionState, + TCP_ConnectionBuffer_t* Buffer); /**< Port application handler */ + } TCP_PortState_t; + + /** Type define for a TCP packet header. */ + typedef struct + { + uint16_t SourcePort; /**< Source port of the TCP packet */ + uint16_t DestinationPort; /**< Destination port of the TCP packet */ + + uint32_t SequenceNumber; /**< Data sequence number of the packet */ + uint32_t AcknowledgmentNumber; /**< Data acknowledgment number of the packet */ + + unsigned Reserved : 4; /**< Reserved, must be all 0 */ + unsigned DataOffset : 4; /**< Offset of the data from the start of the header, in 4 byte chunks */ + uint8_t Flags; /**< TCP packet flags */ + uint16_t WindowSize; /**< Current data window size (bytes remaining in reception buffer) */ + + uint16_t Checksum; /**< TCP checksum */ + uint16_t UrgentPointer; /**< Urgent data pointer */ + } TCP_Header_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void TCP_Init(void); + void TCP_Task(void); + bool TCP_SetPortState(const uint16_t Port, + const uint8_t State, + void (*Handler)(TCP_ConnectionState_t*, TCP_ConnectionBuffer_t*)); + uint8_t TCP_GetPortState(const uint16_t Port); + bool TCP_SetConnectionState(const uint16_t Port, + const IP_Address_t* RemoteAddress, + const uint16_t RemotePort, + const uint8_t State); + uint8_t TCP_GetConnectionState(const uint16_t Port, + const IP_Address_t* RemoteAddress, + const uint16_t RemotePort); + TCP_ConnectionInfo_t* TCP_GetConnectionInfo(const uint16_t Port, + const IP_Address_t* RemoteAddress, + const uint16_t RemotePort); + int16_t TCP_ProcessTCPPacket(void* IPHeaderInStart, + void* TCPHeaderInStart, + void* TCPHeaderOutStart); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_TCP_C) + static uint16_t TCP_Checksum16(void* TCPHeaderOutStart, + const IP_Address_t* SourceAddress, + const IP_Address_t* DestinationAddress, + uint16_t TCPOutSize); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/UDP.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/UDP.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..03c19e00ed --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/UDP.c @@ -0,0 +1,84 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * User Datagram Protocol (UDP) packet handling routines. This protocol handles high throughput, low + * reliability packets which are typically used to encapsulate streaming data. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_UDP_C +#include "UDP.h" + +/** Processes a UDP packet inside an Ethernet frame, and writes the appropriate response + * to the output Ethernet frame if a sub-protocol handler has created a response packet. + * + * \param[in] IPHeaderInStart Pointer to the start of the incoming packet's IP header + * \param[in] UDPHeaderInStart Pointer to the start of the incoming packet's UDP header + * \param[out] UDPHeaderOutStart Pointer to the start of the outgoing packet's UDP header + * + * \return The number of bytes written to the out Ethernet frame if any, NO_RESPONSE otherwise + */ +int16_t UDP_ProcessUDPPacket(void* IPHeaderInStart, + void* UDPHeaderInStart, + void* UDPHeaderOutStart) +{ + UDP_Header_t* UDPHeaderIN = (UDP_Header_t*)UDPHeaderInStart; + UDP_Header_t* UDPHeaderOUT = (UDP_Header_t*)UDPHeaderOutStart; + + int16_t RetSize = NO_RESPONSE; + + DecodeUDPHeader(UDPHeaderInStart); + + switch (SwapEndian_16(UDPHeaderIN->DestinationPort)) + { + case UDP_PORT_DHCP_REQUEST: + RetSize = DHCP_ProcessDHCPPacket(IPHeaderInStart, + &((uint8_t*)UDPHeaderInStart)[sizeof(UDP_Header_t)], + &((uint8_t*)UDPHeaderOutStart)[sizeof(UDP_Header_t)]); + break; + } + + /* Check to see if the protocol processing routine has filled out a response */ + if (RetSize > 0) + { + /* Fill out the response UDP packet header */ + UDPHeaderOUT->SourcePort = UDPHeaderIN->DestinationPort; + UDPHeaderOUT->DestinationPort = UDPHeaderIN->SourcePort; + UDPHeaderOUT->Checksum = 0; + UDPHeaderOUT->Length = SwapEndian_16(sizeof(UDP_Header_t) + RetSize); + + /* Return the size of the response so far */ + return (sizeof(UDP_Header_t) + RetSize); + } + + return NO_RESPONSE; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/UDP.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/UDP.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d008cb8ed8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/UDP.h @@ -0,0 +1,73 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for UDP.c. + */ + +#ifndef _UDP_H_ +#define _UDP_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + + #include "EthernetProtocols.h" + #include "Ethernet.h" + #include "ProtocolDecoders.h" + #include "DHCP.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Source UDP port for a DHCP request. */ + #define UDP_PORT_DHCP_REQUEST 67 + + /** Destination UDP port for a DHCP reply. */ + #define UDP_PORT_DHCP_REPLY 68 + + /** Source UDP port for a DNS request/response. */ + #define UDP_PORT_DNS 53 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a UDP packet header. */ + typedef struct + { + uint16_t SourcePort; /**< Packet source port */ + uint16_t DestinationPort; /**< Packet destination port */ + uint16_t Length; /**< Total packet length, in bytes */ + uint16_t Checksum; /**< Optional UDP packet checksum */ + } UDP_Header_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + int16_t UDP_ProcessUDPPacket(void* IPHeaderInStart, + void* UDPHeaderInStart, + void* UDPHeaderOutStart); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Webserver.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Webserver.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e0d9e36473 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Webserver.c @@ -0,0 +1,203 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Simple webserver application for demonstrating the RNDIS demo and TCP/IP stack. This + * application will serve up a static HTTP webpage when requested by the host. + */ + +#include "Webserver.h" + +/** HTTP server response header, for transmission before the page contents. This indicates to the host that a page exists at the + * given location, and gives extra connection information. + */ +const char PROGMEM HTTP200Header[] = "HTTP/1.1 200 OK\r\n" + "Server: LUFA RNDIS\r\n" + "Content-type: text/html\r\n" + "Connection: close\r\n\r\n"; + +/** HTTP server response header, for transmission before a resource not found error. This indicates to the host that the given + * given URL is invalid, and gives extra error information. + */ +const char PROGMEM HTTP404Header[] = "HTTP/1.1 404 Not Found\r\n" + "Server: LUFA RNDIS\r\n" + "Connection: close\r\n\r\n"; + +/** HTTP page to serve to the host when a HTTP request is made. This page is too long for a single response, thus it is automatically + * broken up into smaller blocks and sent as a series of packets each time the webserver application callback is run. + */ +const char PROGMEM HTTPPage[] = + "<html>" + " <head>" + " <title>" + " LUFA Webserver Demo" + " </title>" + " </head>" + " <body>" + " <h1>Hello from your USB AVR!</h1>" + " <p>" + " Hello! Welcome to the LUFA RNDIS Demo Webserver test page, running on your USB AVR via the LUFA library. This demonstrates the HTTP webserver, TCP/IP stack and RNDIS demo all running atop the LUFA USB stack." + " <br /><br />" + " <small>Project Information: <a href=\"http://www.lufa-lib.org\">http://www.lufa-lib.org</a>.</small>" + " <hr />" + " <i>LUFA Version: </i>" LUFA_VERSION_STRING + " </p>" + " </body>" + "</html>"; + + +/** Initializes the Webserver application, opening the appropriate HTTP port in the TCP handler and registering the application + * callback routine for packets sent to the HTTP protocol port. + */ +void Webserver_Init(void) +{ + /* Open the HTTP port in the TCP protocol so that HTTP connections to the device can be established */ + TCP_SetPortState(TCP_PORT_HTTP, TCP_Port_Open, Webserver_ApplicationCallback); +} + +/** Indicates if a given request equals the given HTTP command. + * + * \param[in] RequestHeader HTTP request made by the host + * \param[in] Command HTTP command to compare the request to + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command matches the request, \c false otherwise + */ +static bool IsHTTPCommand(uint8_t* RequestHeader, + char* Command) +{ + /* Returns true if the non null terminated string in RequestHeader matches the null terminated string Command */ + return (strncmp((char*)RequestHeader, Command, strlen(Command)) == 0); +} + +/** Application callback routine, executed each time the TCP processing task runs. This callback determines what request + * has been made (if any), and serves up appropriate responses. + * + * \param[in] ConnectionState Pointer to a TCP Connection State structure giving connection information + * \param[in,out] Buffer Pointer to the application's send/receive packet buffer + */ +void Webserver_ApplicationCallback(TCP_ConnectionState_t* const ConnectionState, + TCP_ConnectionBuffer_t* const Buffer) +{ + char* BufferDataStr = (char*)Buffer->Data; + static uint8_t PageBlock = 0; + + /* Check to see if a packet has been received on the HTTP port from a remote host */ + if (TCP_APP_HAS_RECEIVED_PACKET(Buffer)) + { + if (IsHTTPCommand(Buffer->Data, "GET")) + { + if (IsHTTPCommand(Buffer->Data, "GET / ")) + { + PageBlock = 0; + + /* Copy the HTTP 200 response header into the packet buffer */ + strcpy_P(BufferDataStr, HTTP200Header); + + /* Send the buffer contents to the host */ + TCP_APP_SEND_BUFFER(Buffer, strlen(BufferDataStr)); + + /* Lock the buffer to Device->Host transmissions only while we send the page contents */ + TCP_APP_CAPTURE_BUFFER(Buffer); + } + else + { + /* Copy the HTTP 404 response header into the packet buffer */ + strcpy_P(BufferDataStr, HTTP404Header); + + /* Send the buffer contents to the host */ + TCP_APP_SEND_BUFFER(Buffer, strlen(BufferDataStr)); + + /* All data sent, close the connection */ + TCP_APP_CLOSECONNECTION(ConnectionState); + } + } + else if (IsHTTPCommand(Buffer->Data, "HEAD")) + { + if (IsHTTPCommand(Buffer->Data, "HEAD / ")) + { + /* Copy the HTTP response header into the packet buffer */ + strcpy_P(BufferDataStr, HTTP200Header); + + /* Send the buffer contents to the host */ + TCP_APP_SEND_BUFFER(Buffer, strlen(BufferDataStr)); + } + else + { + /* Copy the HTTP response header into the packet buffer */ + strcpy_P(BufferDataStr, HTTP404Header); + + /* Send the buffer contents to the host */ + TCP_APP_SEND_BUFFER(Buffer, strlen(BufferDataStr)); + } + + /* All data sent, close the connection */ + TCP_APP_CLOSECONNECTION(ConnectionState); + } + else if (IsHTTPCommand(Buffer->Data, "TRACE")) + { + /* Echo the host's query back to the host */ + TCP_APP_SEND_BUFFER(Buffer, Buffer->Length); + + /* All data sent, close the connection */ + TCP_APP_CLOSECONNECTION(ConnectionState); + } + else + { + /* Unknown request, just clear the buffer (drop the packet) */ + TCP_APP_CLEAR_BUFFER(Buffer); + } + } + else if (TCP_APP_HAVE_CAPTURED_BUFFER(Buffer)) + { + uint16_t RemLength = strlen_P(&HTTPPage[PageBlock * HTTP_REPLY_BLOCK_SIZE]); + uint16_t Length; + + /* Determine the length of the loaded block */ + Length = MIN(RemLength, HTTP_REPLY_BLOCK_SIZE); + + /* Copy the next buffer sized block of the page to the packet buffer */ + strncpy_P(BufferDataStr, &HTTPPage[PageBlock * HTTP_REPLY_BLOCK_SIZE], Length); + + /* Send the buffer contents to the host */ + TCP_APP_SEND_BUFFER(Buffer, Length); + + /* Check to see if the entire page has been sent */ + if (PageBlock++ == (sizeof(HTTPPage) / HTTP_REPLY_BLOCK_SIZE)) + { + /* Unlock the buffer so that the host can fill it with future packets */ + TCP_APP_RELEASE_BUFFER(Buffer); + + /* Close the connection to the host */ + TCP_APP_CLOSECONNECTION(ConnectionState); + } + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Webserver.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Webserver.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a73bd33384 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/Lib/Webserver.h @@ -0,0 +1,57 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Webserver.c. + */ + +#ifndef _WEBSERVER_H_ +#define _WEBSERVER_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Version.h> + + #include "TCP.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Maximum size of a HTTP response per transmission */ + #define HTTP_REPLY_BLOCK_SIZE 128 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void Webserver_Init(void); + void Webserver_ApplicationCallback(TCP_ConnectionState_t* const ConnectionState, + TCP_ConnectionBuffer_t* const Buffer); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f1dd7a7885 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.c @@ -0,0 +1,294 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the RNDISEthernet demo. This file contains the main tasks of the demo and + * is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "RNDISEthernet.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + /* Webserver Initialization */ + TCP_Init(); + Webserver_Init(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + Ethernet_Task(); + TCP_Task(); + RNDIS_Task(); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + Serial_Init(9600, false); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB enumerating */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via + * the status LEDs and stops all the relevant tasks. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB not ready */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This is fired when the host sets the current configuration + * of the USB device after enumeration, and configures the RNDIS device endpoints and starts the relevant tasks. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + /* Setup RNDIS Data Endpoints */ + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, 1); + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, 1); + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, 1); + + /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to + * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing + * internally. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + /* Process RNDIS class commands */ + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case RNDIS_REQ_SendEncapsulatedCommand: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Read in the RNDIS message into the message buffer */ + Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE(RNDISMessageBuffer, USB_ControlRequest.wLength); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Process the RNDIS message */ + ProcessRNDISControlMessage(); + } + + break; + case RNDIS_REQ_GetEncapsulatedResponse: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + /* Check if a response to the last message is ready */ + if (!(MessageHeader->MessageLength)) + { + /* Set the response to a single 0x00 byte to indicate that no response is ready */ + RNDISMessageBuffer[0] = 0; + MessageHeader->MessageLength = 1; + } + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Write the message response data to the endpoint */ + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(RNDISMessageBuffer, MessageHeader->MessageLength); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + /* Reset the message header once again after transmission */ + MessageHeader->MessageLength = 0; + } + + break; + } +} + +/** Task to manage the sending and receiving of encapsulated RNDIS data and notifications. This removes the RNDIS + * wrapper from received Ethernet frames and places them in the FrameIN global buffer, or adds the RNDIS wrapper + * to a frame in the FrameOUT global before sending the buffer contents to the host. + */ +void RNDIS_Task(void) +{ + /* Select the notification endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR); + + /* Check if a message response is ready for the host */ + if (Endpoint_IsINReady() && ResponseReady) + { + USB_Request_Header_t Notification = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = RNDIS_NOTIF_ResponseAvailable, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + /* Indicate that a message response is ready for the host */ + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&Notification, sizeof(Notification), NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Indicate a response is no longer ready */ + ResponseReady = false; + } + + /* Don't process the data endpoints until the system is in the data initialized state, and the buffer is free */ + if ((CurrRNDISState == RNDIS_Data_Initialized) && !(MessageHeader->MessageLength)) + { + /* Create a new packet header for reading/writing */ + RNDIS_Packet_Message_t RNDISPacketHeader; + + /* Select the data OUT endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPADDR); + + /* Check if the data OUT endpoint contains data, and that the IN buffer is empty */ + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived() && !(FrameIN.FrameLength)) + { + /* Read in the packet message header */ + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&RNDISPacketHeader, sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t), NULL); + + /* Stall the request if the data is too large */ + if (RNDISPacketHeader.DataLength > ETHERNET_FRAME_SIZE_MAX) + { + Endpoint_StallTransaction(); + return; + } + + /* Read in the Ethernet frame into the buffer */ + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(FrameIN.FrameData, RNDISPacketHeader.DataLength, NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + /* Store the size of the Ethernet frame */ + FrameIN.FrameLength = RNDISPacketHeader.DataLength; + } + + /* Select the data IN endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPADDR); + + /* Check if the data IN endpoint is ready for more data, and that the IN buffer is full */ + if (Endpoint_IsINReady() && FrameOUT.FrameLength) + { + /* Clear the packet header with all 0s so that the relevant fields can be filled */ + memset(&RNDISPacketHeader, 0, sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t)); + + /* Construct the required packet header fields in the buffer */ + RNDISPacketHeader.MessageType = REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_MSG; + RNDISPacketHeader.MessageLength = (sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t) + FrameOUT.FrameLength); + RNDISPacketHeader.DataOffset = (sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t) - sizeof(RNDIS_Message_Header_t)); + RNDISPacketHeader.DataLength = FrameOUT.FrameLength; + + /* Send the packet header to the host */ + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&RNDISPacketHeader, sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t), NULL); + + /* Send the Ethernet frame data to the host */ + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(FrameOUT.FrameData, RNDISPacketHeader.DataLength, NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Indicate Ethernet OUT buffer no longer full */ + FrameOUT.FrameLength = 0; + } + } +} + +/** Ethernet frame processing task. This task checks to see if a frame has been received, and if so hands off the processing + * of the frame to the Ethernet processing routines. + */ +void Ethernet_Task(void) +{ + /* Task for Ethernet processing. Incoming ethernet frames are loaded into the FrameIN structure, and + outgoing frames should be loaded into the FrameOUT structure. Both structures can only hold a single + Ethernet frame at a time, so the FrameInBuffer bool is used to indicate when the buffers contain data. */ + + /* Device must be connected and configured for the task to run */ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Check if a frame has been written to the IN frame buffer */ + if (FrameIN.FrameLength) + { + /* Indicate packet processing started */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + + /* Process the ethernet frame - replace this with your own Ethernet handler code as desired */ + Ethernet_ProcessPacket(); + + /* Indicate packet processing complete */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..89858a58b2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.h @@ -0,0 +1,87 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for RNDISEthernet.c. + */ + +#ifndef _RNDISETHERNET_H_ +#define _RNDISETHERNET_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include "Lib/RNDIS.h" + #include "Lib/Ethernet.h" + #include "Lib/TCP.h" + #include "Lib/ARP.h" + #include "Lib/Webserver.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void RNDIS_Task(void); + void Ethernet_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a2c2ac604b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.txt @@ -0,0 +1,146 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage RNDIS Class Ethernet Demo (with Webserver/Telnet) + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Remote NDIS (Microsoft Proprietary CDC Class Networking Standard)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>Microsoft RNDIS Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Remote Network Driver Interface demonstration application. + * This gives a simple reference application for implementing + * a CDC RNDIS device acting as a simple network interface for + * ethernet packet exchange. RNDIS is a proprietary Microsoft + * standard; this demo will only work on Windows 2000 (manually + * patched with the Microsoft RNDIS hotfix) and above (with no + * manual patches), or on the latest Linux kernels. + * + * Before running, you will need to install the INF file that + * is located in the RNDISEthernet project directory. This will + * enable Windows to use its inbuilt RNDIS drivers, negating the + * need for special Windows drivers for the device. To install, + * right-click the .INF file and choose the Install option. If + * Windows 2000 is used, the Microsoft INF file in the hotfix + * will need to be altered to use the VID/PID of the demo and + * then chosen instead of the LUFA RNDIS INF file when prompted. + * + * When enumerated, this demo will install as a new network + * adapter which ethernet packets can be sent to and received + * from. Running on top of the adapter is a very simple TCP/IP + * stack with a HTTP webserver and TELNET host which can be + * accessed through a web browser at IP address 10.0.0.2:80 or + * through a TELNET client at 10.0.0.2:25. This device also supports + * ping echos via the ICMP protocol. + * + * \note The TCP/IP stack in this demo has a number of limitations + * and should serve as an example only - it is not fully featured nor + * compliant to the TCP/IP specification. For complete projects, it is + * recommended that it be replaced with an external open source TCP/IP + * stack that is feature complete, such as the uIP stack. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>CLIENT_IP_ADDRESS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Configures the IP address given to the client (PC) via the DHCP server.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>SERVER_IP_ADDRESS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Configures the IP address of the virtual server.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ADAPTER_MAC_ADDRESS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Configures the MAC address of the RNDIS adapter on the host (PC) side.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Configures the MAC address of the virtual server on the network.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_DECODE_ETHERNET</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, received Ethernet headers will not be decoded and printed to the device serial port.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_DECODE_ARP</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, received ARP headers will not be decoded and printed to the device serial port.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_DECODE_IP</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, received IP headers will not be decoded and printed to the device serial port.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_DECODE_ICMP</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, received ICMP headers will not be decoded and printed to the device serial port.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_DECODE_TCP</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, received TCP headers will not be decoded and printed to the device serial port.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_DECODE_UDP</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, received UDP headers will not be decoded and printed to the device serial port.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_DECODE_DHCP</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, received DHCP headers will not be decoded and printed to the device serial port.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5bdbf635fd --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,86 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="RNDIS Ethernet Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.rndis.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.rndis"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="RNDIS Ethernet Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.rndis.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.rndis"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.rndis" caption="RNDIS Ethernet Device Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Microsoft RNDIS Ethernet networking device demo, implementing a basic HTTP webserver. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="RNDIS Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="RNDISEthernet.txt"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="LUFA RNDIS.inf"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="RNDISEthernet.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/ARP.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/DHCP.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/Ethernet.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/ICMP.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/IP.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/ProtocolDecoders.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/RNDIS.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/TCP.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/UDP.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/Webserver.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="RNDISEthernet.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/ARP.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/DHCP.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/Ethernet.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/ICMP.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/IP.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/ProtocolDecoders.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/RNDIS.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/TCP.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/UDP.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/Webserver.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/EthernetProtocols.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..29d07c317f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - RNDIS Ethernet Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..82687c1f15 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/RNDISEthernet/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,44 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = RNDISEthernet +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c Lib/Ethernet.c Lib/ProtocolDecoders.c Lib/RNDIS.c Lib/ICMP.c Lib/TCP.c Lib/UDP.c \ + Lib/DHCP.c Lib/ARP.c Lib/IP.c Lib/Webserver.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c2d3227ac2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX 4 +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5ec042cb04 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,245 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2044, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .CDC_CCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Header = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .CDCSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + }, + + .CDC_Functional_ACM = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ACM, + + .Capabilities = 0x06, + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Union = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Union, + + .MasterInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .SlaveInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + }, + + .CDC_NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0xFF + }, + + .CDC_DCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .CDC_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA CDC Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c50899ef9a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,110 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 2) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_TX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define CDC_RX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE 8 + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC data IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE 16 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // CDC Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_CCI_Interface; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t CDC_Functional_Header; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t CDC_Functional_ACM; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t CDC_Functional_Union; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_NotificationEndpoint; + + // CDC Data Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_DCI_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataOutEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataInEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI = 0, /**< CDC CCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI = 1, /**< CDC DCI interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/LUFA VirtualSerial.inf b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/LUFA VirtualSerial.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..21d2d12b6e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/LUFA VirtualSerial.inf @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +;************************************************************ +; Windows USB CDC ACM Setup File +; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation +;************************************************************ + +[DefaultInstall] +CopyINF="LUFA VirtualSerial.inf" + +[Version] +Signature="$Windows NT$" +Class=Ports +ClassGuid={4D36E978-E325-11CE-BFC1-08002BE10318} +Provider=%MFGNAME% +DriverVer=7/1/2012,10.0.0.0 + +[Manufacturer] +%MFGNAME%=DeviceList, NTx86, NTamd64, NTia64 + +[SourceDisksNames] + +[SourceDisksFiles] + +[DestinationDirs] +DefaultDestDir=12 + +[DriverInstall] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +CopyFiles=FakeModemCopyFileSection +AddReg=DriverInstall.AddReg + +[DriverInstall.Services] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +AddService=usbser, 0x00000002, LowerFilter_Service_Inst + +[DriverInstall.AddReg] +HKR,,EnumPropPages32,,"msports.dll,SerialPortPropPageProvider" + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; Vendor and Product ID Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; When developing your USB device, the VID and PID used in the PC side +; application program and the firmware on the microcontroller must match. +; Modify the below line to use your VID and PID. Use the format as shown below. +; Note: One INF file can be used for multiple devices with different VID and PIDs. +; For each supported device, append ",USB\VID_xxxx&PID_yyyy" to the end of the line. +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[DeviceList] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2044 + +[DeviceList.NTx86] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2044 + +[DeviceList.NTamd64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2044 + +[DeviceList.NTia64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2044 + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; String Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +;Modify these strings to customize your device +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[Strings] +MFGNAME="http://www.lufa-lib.org" +DESCRIPTION="LUFA CDC-ACM Virtual Serial Port"
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/VirtualSerial.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/VirtualSerial.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6f83a84af0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/VirtualSerial.c @@ -0,0 +1,243 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the VirtualSerial demo. This file contains the main tasks of the demo and + * is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "VirtualSerial.h" + +/** Contains the current baud rate and other settings of the virtual serial port. While this demo does not use + * the physical USART and thus does not use these settings, they must still be retained and returned to the host + * upon request or the host will assume the device is non-functional. + * + * These values are set by the host via a class-specific request, however they are not required to be used accurately. + * It is possible to completely ignore these value or use other settings as the host is completely unaware of the physical + * serial link characteristics and instead sends and receives data in endpoint streams. + */ +static CDC_LineEncoding_t LineEncoding = { .BaudRateBPS = 0, + .CharFormat = CDC_LINEENCODING_OneStopBit, + .ParityType = CDC_PARITY_None, + .DataBits = 8 }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + CDC_Task(); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Joystick_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB enumerating */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via + * the status LEDs and stops the USB management and CDC management tasks. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + /* Indicate USB not ready */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This is fired when the host set the current configuration + * of the USB device after enumeration - the device endpoints are configured and the CDC management task started. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + /* Setup CDC Data Endpoints */ + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, 1); + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, 1); + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, 1); + + /* Reset line encoding baud rate so that the host knows to send new values */ + LineEncoding.BaudRateBPS = 0; + + /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to + * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing + * internally. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + /* Process CDC specific control requests */ + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case CDC_REQ_GetLineEncoding: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Write the line coding data to the control endpoint */ + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(&LineEncoding, sizeof(CDC_LineEncoding_t)); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + + break; + case CDC_REQ_SetLineEncoding: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + /* Read the line coding data in from the host into the global struct */ + Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE(&LineEncoding, sizeof(CDC_LineEncoding_t)); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } + + break; + case CDC_REQ_SetControlLineState: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + /* NOTE: Here you can read in the line state mask from the host, to get the current state of the output handshake + lines. The mask is read in from the wValue parameter in USB_ControlRequest, and can be masked against the + CONTROL_LINE_OUT_* masks to determine the RTS and DTR line states using the following code: + */ + } + + break; + } +} + +/** Function to manage CDC data transmission and reception to and from the host. */ +void CDC_Task(void) +{ + char* ReportString = NULL; + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + static bool ActionSent = false; + + /* Device must be connected and configured for the task to run */ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Determine if a joystick action has occurred */ + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + ReportString = "Joystick Up\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + ReportString = "Joystick Down\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + ReportString = "Joystick Left\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + ReportString = "Joystick Right\r\n"; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + ReportString = "Joystick Pressed\r\n"; + else + ActionSent = false; + + /* Flag management - Only allow one string to be sent per action */ + if ((ReportString != NULL) && (ActionSent == false) && LineEncoding.BaudRateBPS) + { + ActionSent = true; + + /* Select the Serial Tx Endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPADDR); + + /* Write the String to the Endpoint */ + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(ReportString, strlen(ReportString), NULL); + + /* Remember if the packet to send completely fills the endpoint */ + bool IsFull = (Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint() == CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* If the last packet filled the endpoint, send an empty packet to release the buffer on + * the receiver (otherwise all data will be cached until a non-full packet is received) */ + if (IsFull) + { + /* Wait until the endpoint is ready for another packet */ + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + + /* Send an empty packet to ensure that the host does not buffer data sent to it */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } + } + + /* Select the Serial Rx Endpoint */ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPADDR); + + /* Throw away any received data from the host */ + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/VirtualSerial.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/VirtualSerial.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dab3d56d6c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/VirtualSerial.h @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for VirtualSerial.c. + */ + +#ifndef _VIRTUALSERIAL_H_ +#define _VIRTUALSERIAL_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void CDC_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/VirtualSerial.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/VirtualSerial.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c802d99504 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/VirtualSerial.txt @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Communications Device Class (Virtual Serial Port) Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * \li Series AU XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxAxU) + * \li Series B XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxBx) + * \li Series C XMEGA AVRs (ATXMEGAxxxCx) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Abstract Control Model (ACM)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF CDC Class Standard</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Communications Device Class demonstration application. + * This gives a simple reference application for implementing + * a CDC device acting as a virtual serial port. Joystick + * actions are transmitted to the host as strings. The device + * does not respond to serial data sent from the host. + * + * After running this demo for the first time on a new computer, + * you will need to supply the .INF file located in this demo + * project's directory as the device's driver when running under + * Windows. This will enable Windows to use its inbuilt CDC drivers, + * negating the need for custom drivers for the device. Other + * Operating Systems should automatically use their own inbuilt + * CDC-ACM drivers. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1eb328b510 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,63 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Virtual Serial CDC Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.cdc.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.cdc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="Virtual Serial CDC Device Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.cdc.example.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.cdc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.device.lowlevel.cdc" caption="Virtual Serial CDC Device Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Virtual Serial device demo, implementing a virtual serial channel between the host PC and the device. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="CDC Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="VirtualSerial.txt"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="LUFA VirtualSerial.inf"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="VirtualSerial.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="VirtualSerial.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..aa21df5823 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Virtual Serial Device Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b33840cae3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/VirtualSerial/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = VirtualSerial +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a713c9d4cc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/LowLevel/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,46 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +# Makefile to build all the LUFA Device Demos. Call with "make all" to +# rebuild all Device demos. + +# Projects are pre-cleaned before each one is built, to ensure any +# custom LUFA library build options are reflected in the compiled +# code. + +PROJECT_DIRECTORIES := $(shell ls -d */) + +# This makefile is potentially infinitely recursive if something really bad +# happens when determining the set of project directories - hard-abort if +# more than 10 levels deep to avoid angry emails. +ifeq ($(MAKELEVEL), 10) + $(error EMERGENCY ABORT: INFINITE RECURSION DETECTED) +endif + +# Need to special-case building without a per-project object directory +ifeq ($(OBJDIR),) + # If no target specified, force "clean all" and disallow parallel build + ifeq ($(MAKECMDGOALS),) + MAKECMDGOALS := clean all + .NOTPARALLEL: + endif + + # If one of the targets is to build, force "clean" beforehand and disallow parallel build + ifneq ($(findstring all, $(MAKECMDGOALS)),) + MAKECMDGOALS := clean $(MAKECMDGOALS) + .NOTPARALLEL: + endif +endif + +%: $(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES) + @echo . > /dev/null + +$(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES): + @$(MAKE) -C $@ $(MAKECMDGOALS) + +.PHONY: $(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES) diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..abeb3f4a81 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Device/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,21 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +# Makefile to build all the LUFA Class Driver and Low Level Demos. Call with +# "make all" to rebuild all demos of both types. + +# Projects are pre-cleaned before each one is built, to ensure any +# custom LUFA library build options are reflected in the compiled +# code. + +all: + +%: + $(MAKE) -C ClassDriver $@ + $(MAKE) -C LowLevel $@ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0a8074e71b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9889422a56 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,221 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the + * USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This + * descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding) + * the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for + * more details on HID report descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t PROGMEM MouseReport[] = +{ + /* Use the HID class driver's standard Mouse report. + * Min X/Y Axis values: -1 + * Max X/Y Axis values: 1 + * Min physical X/Y Axis values (used to determine resolution): -1 + * Max physical X/Y Axis values (used to determine resolution): 1 + * Buttons: 3 + * Absolute screen coordinates: false + */ + HID_DESCRIPTOR_MOUSE(-1, 1, -1, 1, 3, false) +}; + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2041, + .ReleaseNumber = 0x0000, + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .HID_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Mouse, + .AlternateSetting = 0x00, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_BootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_MouseBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID_MouseHID = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(MouseReport) + }, + + .HID_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MOUSE_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MOUSE_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Mouse Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + case HID_DTYPE_HID: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID_MouseHID; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + break; + case HID_DTYPE_Report: + Address = &MouseReport; + Size = sizeof(MouseReport); + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d5fdd3c888 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Mouse HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID_Interface; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID_MouseHID; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID_ReportINEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_Mouse = 0, /**< Mouse interface descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Mouse HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define MOUSE_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Size in bytes of the Mouse HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define MOUSE_EPSIZE 8 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/DeviceFunctions.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/DeviceFunctions.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3598462be6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/DeviceFunctions.c @@ -0,0 +1,155 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Device Mode USB Mouse functionality for the MouseHostDevice demo. This file contains the Device mode + * USB Mouse related code of the demo and is responsible for all the Device mode Mouse functionality. + */ + +#include "DeviceFunctions.h" + +/** Buffer to hold the previously generated Mouse Device HID report, for comparison purposes inside the HID class driver. */ +static uint8_t PrevMouseHIDReportBuffer[sizeof(USB_MouseReport_Data_t)]; + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t Mouse_HID_Device_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Mouse, + .ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Address = MOUSE_EPADDR, + .Size = MOUSE_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .PrevReportINBuffer = PrevMouseHIDReportBuffer, + .PrevReportINBufferSize = sizeof(PrevMouseHIDReportBuffer), + }, + }; + + +/** Event handler for the library USB WakeUp event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Suspend event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + + if (!(HID_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Mouse_HID_Device_Interface))) + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + + USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + HID_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Mouse_HID_Device_Interface); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB device Start Of Frame event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void) +{ + HID_Device_MillisecondElapsed(&Mouse_HID_Device_Interface); +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the creation of HID reports to the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in,out] ReportID Report ID requested by the host if non-zero, otherwise callback should set to the generated report ID + * \param[in] ReportType Type of the report to create, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_In or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[out] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the created report should be stored + * \param[out] ReportSize Number of bytes written in the report (or zero if no report is to be sent) + * + * \return Boolean \c true to force the sending of the report, \c false to let the library determine if it needs to be sent + */ +bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize) +{ + USB_MouseReport_Data_t* MouseReport = (USB_MouseReport_Data_t*)ReportData; + + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + uint8_t ButtonStatus_LCL = Buttons_GetStatus(); + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + MouseReport->Y = -1; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + MouseReport->Y = 1; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + MouseReport->X = 1; + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + MouseReport->X = -1; + + if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) + MouseReport->Button |= (1 << 0); + + if (ButtonStatus_LCL & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) + MouseReport->Button |= (1 << 1); + + *ReportSize = sizeof(USB_MouseReport_Data_t); + return true; +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the processing of HID reports from the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in] ReportID Report ID of the received report from the host + * \param[in] ReportType The type of report that the host has sent, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_Out or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[in] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the received report has been stored + * \param[in] ReportSize Size in bytes of the received HID report + */ +void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize) +{ + // Unused (but mandatory for the HID class driver) in this demo, since there are no Host->Device reports +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/DeviceFunctions.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/DeviceFunctions.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..36ad50acf3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/DeviceFunctions.h @@ -0,0 +1,64 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for DeviceFunctions.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MOUSE_DEVICE_FUNCTIONS_H_ +#define _MOUSE_DEVICE_FUNCTIONS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "MouseHostDevice.h" + + /* External Variables: */ + extern USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t Mouse_HID_Device_Interface; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize); + void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/HostFunctions.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/HostFunctions.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8e602add1b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/HostFunctions.c @@ -0,0 +1,184 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Host Mode USB Mouse functionality for the MouseHostDevice demo. This file contains the Host mode + * USB Mouse related code of the demo and is responsible for all the Host mode Mouse functionality. + */ + +#include "HostFunctions.h" + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t Mouse_HID_Host_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .DataINPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataINPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .HIDInterfaceProtocol = HID_CSCP_MouseBootProtocol, + }, + }; + + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Device Attached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize; + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData, + sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData)) != HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful) + { + printf("Error Retrieving Configuration Descriptor.\r\n"); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (HID_Host_ConfigurePipes(&Mouse_HID_Host_Interface, + ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData) != HID_ENUMERROR_NoError) + { + printf("Attached Device Not a Valid Mouse.\r\n"); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf("Error Setting Device Configuration.\r\n"); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (HID_Host_SetBootProtocol(&Mouse_HID_Host_Interface) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf("Could not Set Boot Protocol Mode.\r\n"); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + printf("Mouse Enumerated.\r\n"); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Host USB management task. This task handles the control of USB Mice while in USB Host mode, + * setting up the appropriate data pipes and processing reports from the attached device. + */ +void MouseHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + if (HID_Host_IsReportReceived(&Mouse_HID_Host_Interface)) + { + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS; + + USB_MouseReport_Data_t MouseReport; + HID_Host_ReceiveReport(&Mouse_HID_Host_Interface, &MouseReport); + + printf_P(PSTR("dX:%2d dY:%2d Button:%d\r\n"), MouseReport.X, + MouseReport.Y, + MouseReport.Button); + if (MouseReport.X > 0) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED1; + else if (MouseReport.X < 0) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED2; + + if (MouseReport.Y > 0) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED3; + else if (MouseReport.Y < 0) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED4; + + if (MouseReport.Button) + LEDMask = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/HostFunctions.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/HostFunctions.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..02d4e72474 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/HostFunctions.h @@ -0,0 +1,56 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for HostFunctions.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MOUSE_HOST_FUNCTIONS_H_ +#define _MOUSE_HOST_FUNCTIONS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "MouseHostDevice.h" + + /* External Variables: */ + extern USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t Mouse_HID_Host_Interface; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void MouseHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/MouseHostDevice.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/MouseHostDevice.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fc6421ac02 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/MouseHostDevice.c @@ -0,0 +1,99 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the MouseHostDevice demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the overall control flow of the demo. + */ + +#include "MouseHostDevice.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Mouse Host/Device Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + /* Determine which USB mode we are currently in */ + if (USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Host) + { + MouseHost_Task(); + HID_Host_USBTask(&Mouse_HID_Host_Interface); + } + else + { + HID_Device_USBTask(&Mouse_HID_Device_Interface); + } + + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + Joystick_Init(); + Buttons_Init(); + USB_Init(USB_MODE_UID); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB mode change event. */ +void EVENT_USB_UIDChange(void) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_YELLOW "UID Change to %S mode\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), + (USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Device) ? PSTR("Device") : PSTR("Host")); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/MouseHostDevice.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/MouseHostDevice.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4b6fe4f6de --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/MouseHostDevice.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for MouseHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MOUSE_HOST_DEVICE_H_ +#define _MOUSE_HOST_DEVICE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + #include "DeviceFunctions.h" + #include "HostFunctions.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_UIDChange(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/MouseHostDevice.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/MouseHostDevice.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d3fb9a5618 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/MouseHostDevice.txt @@ -0,0 +1,80 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Mouse Host/Device Dual Role Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Dual Mode Host/Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification, USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode, Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Mouse host/device dual role demonstration application. This gives a simple + * reference application for implementing a dual role USB Mouse, for USB mice + * using the standard mouse boot protocol HID profile. + * + * <b>When in host mode:</b> + * Mouse movement and button presses are displayed on the board LEDs, + * as well as printed out the serial terminal as formatted dY, dY and + * button status information. + * + * This uses a naive method where the mouse is set to Boot Protocol mode, so + * that the report structure is fixed and known. A better implementation + * uses the HID report parser for correct report data processing across + * all compatible mice with advanced characteristics, as shown in the + * MouseHostWithParser Host demo application. + * + * Currently only single interface mice are supported. + * + * <b>When in device mode:</b> + * Upon enumeration the system will automatically enumerate and function + * as a mouse when the USB connection to a host is present. To use + * the mouse, move the joystick to move the pointer, and push the + * joystick inwards to simulate a left-button click. The HWB serves as + * the right mouse button. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7cd93babb0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,56 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Mouse HID Dual USB Mode Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.dualrole.class.mouse.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.dualrole.class.mouse"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.dualrole.class.mouse" caption="Mouse HID Dual USB Mode Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Mouse host and device dual role demo, implementing a basic mouse device and host. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Dual Role"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="MouseHostDevice.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="MouseHostDevice.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="DeviceFunctions.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="HostFunctions.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="MouseHostDevice.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="DeviceFunctions.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="HostFunctions.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0bfe97d548 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Mouse Host/Device Dual Role Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b965229902 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/MouseHostDevice/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = MouseHostDevice +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c DeviceFunctions.c HostFunctions.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e5cc04939f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/ClassDriver/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,46 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +# Makefile to build all the LUFA Dual Role Demos. Call with "make all" to +# rebuild all Dual Role demos. + +# Projects are pre-cleaned before each one is built, to ensure any +# custom LUFA library build options are reflected in the compiled +# code. + +PROJECT_DIRECTORIES := $(shell ls -d */) + +# This makefile is potentially infinitely recursive if something really bad +# happens when determining the set of project directories - hard-abort if +# more than 10 levels deep to avoid angry emails. +ifeq ($(MAKELEVEL), 10) + $(error EMERGENCY ABORT: INFINITE RECURSION DETECTED) +endif + +# Need to special-case building without a per-project object directory +ifeq ($(OBJDIR),) + # If no target specified, force "clean all" and disallow parallel build + ifeq ($(MAKECMDGOALS),) + MAKECMDGOALS := clean all + .NOTPARALLEL: + endif + + # If one of the targets is to build, force "clean" beforehand and disallow parallel build + ifneq ($(findstring all, $(MAKECMDGOALS)),) + MAKECMDGOALS := clean $(MAKECMDGOALS) + .NOTPARALLEL: + endif +endif + +%: $(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES) + @echo . > /dev/null + +$(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES): + @$(MAKE) -C $@ $(MAKECMDGOALS) + +.PHONY: $(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES) diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f2530c57a1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/DualRole/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,20 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +# Makefile to build all the LUFA Class Driver and Low Level Demos. Call with +# "make all" to rebuild all demos of both types. + +# Projects are pre-cleaned before each one is built, to ensure any +# custom LUFA library build options are reflected in the compiled +# code. + +all: + +%: + $(MAKE) -C ClassDriver $@ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidAccessoryHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidAccessoryHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..48178d68de --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidAccessoryHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,239 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the AndroidAccessoryHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "AndroidAccessoryHost.h" + +/** LUFA Android Open Accessory Class driver interface configuration and state information. This + * structure is passed to all Android Open Accessory Class driver functions, so that multiple + * instances of the same class within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t AndroidDevice_AOA_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .DataINPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .PropertyStrings = + { + [AOA_STRING_Manufacturer] = "Dean Camera", + [AOA_STRING_Model] = "LUFA Android Demo", + [AOA_STRING_Description] = "LUFA Android Demo", + [AOA_STRING_Version] = "1.0", + [AOA_STRING_URI] = "http://www.lufa-lib.org", + [AOA_STRING_Serial] = "0000000012345678", + }, + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Android Accessory Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + AOAHost_Task(); + + AOA_Host_USBTask(&AndroidDevice_AOA_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Task to manage an enumerated USB Android Accessory device once connected, to print received data + * from the device to the serial port. + */ +void AOAHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + if (AOA_Host_BytesReceived(&AndroidDevice_AOA_Interface)) + { + /* Echo received bytes from the attached device through the USART */ + int16_t ReceivedByte = AOA_Host_ReceiveByte(&AndroidDevice_AOA_Interface); + if (!(ReceivedByte < 0)) + { + /* Turn on and off LED1 based on the bytes received */ + LEDs_ChangeLEDs(LEDS_LED1, ReceivedByte ? LEDS_LED1 : LEDS_NO_LEDS); + + putchar(ReceivedByte); + } + } +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Device Attached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor; + + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceDescriptor(&DeviceDescriptor) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Retrieving Device Descriptor.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + bool NeedModeSwitch; + if (!(AOA_Host_ValidateAccessoryDevice(&AndroidDevice_AOA_Interface, &DeviceDescriptor, &NeedModeSwitch))) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Not an Android device.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (NeedModeSwitch) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Not in Accessory mode, switching...\r\n")); + AOA_Host_StartAccessoryMode(&AndroidDevice_AOA_Interface); + return; + } + + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize; + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData, + sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData)) != HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Retrieving Configuration Descriptor.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (AOA_Host_ConfigurePipes(&AndroidDevice_AOA_Interface, + ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData) != AOA_ENUMERROR_NoError) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Attached Device Not a Valid Android Accessory Class Device.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Device Configuration.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Android Device Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidAccessoryHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidAccessoryHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d7c868f7f5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidAccessoryHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,79 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for AndroidAccessoryHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _ANDROIDACCESSORY_HOST_H_ +#define _ANDROIDACCESSORY_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void AOAHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidAccessoryHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidAccessoryHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..63d192d1a5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidAccessoryHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Android Accessory Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Android Accessory Host Class</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>Android Accessory Host Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Android Accessory Host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing an Android Accessory Host device capable of hosting + * Android powered mobile devices to send and receive data. + * + * Data sent from the Android device will be sent out the AVR's serial port. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidHostApp/AndroidHostApp.zip b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidHostApp/AndroidHostApp.zip Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c433d79e16 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidHostApp/AndroidHostApp.zip diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1d840f618c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} + #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS 0 +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..59efae3610 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,49 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Android Accessory Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.class.android.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.class.android"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.class.android" caption="Android Accessory Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Android Accessory Host demo, implementing a basic USB device whose LEDs can be controlled via an Android device. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="Android Accessory Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="AndroidAccessoryHost.txt"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="directory" value="AndroidHostApp"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="AndroidAccessoryHost.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="AndroidAccessoryHost.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6fd6211d32 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Android Accessory Mode Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a769ee3d1b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AndroidAccessoryHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = AndroidAccessoryHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/AudioInputHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/AudioInputHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ad45011512 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/AudioInputHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,239 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the AudioInputHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "AudioInputHost.h" + +/** LUFA Audio Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all Audio Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t Microphone_Audio_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .DataINPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1), + }, + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Audio Input Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + Audio_Host_USBTask(&Microphone_Audio_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** ISR to handle the reloading of the PWM timer with the next sample. */ +ISR(TIMER0_COMPA_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + uint8_t PrevPipe = Pipe_GetCurrentPipe(); + + /* Check that the USB bus is ready for the next sample to read */ + if (Audio_Host_IsSampleReceived(&Microphone_Audio_Interface)) + { + /* Retrieve the signed 16-bit audio sample, convert to 8-bit */ + int8_t Sample_8Bit = (Audio_Host_ReadSample16(&Microphone_Audio_Interface) >> 8); + + /* Load the sample into the PWM timer channel */ + OCR3A = (Sample_8Bit ^ (1 << 7)); + + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS; + + /* Turn on LEDs as the sample amplitude increases */ + if (Sample_8Bit > 16) + LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4); + else if (Sample_8Bit > 8) + LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3); + else if (Sample_8Bit > 4) + LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2); + else if (Sample_8Bit > 2) + LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); + } + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PrevPipe); +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Device Attached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize; + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData, + sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData)) != HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Retrieving Configuration Descriptor.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (Audio_Host_ConfigurePipes(&Microphone_Audio_Interface, + ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData) != AUDIO_ENUMERROR_NoError) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Attached Device Not a Valid Audio Input Device.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Device Configuration.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (Audio_Host_StartStopStreaming(&Microphone_Audio_Interface, true) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Enabling Audio Stream.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + USB_Audio_SampleFreq_t SampleRate = AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(48000); + if (Audio_Host_GetSetEndpointProperty(&Microphone_Audio_Interface, Microphone_Audio_Interface.Config.DataINPipe.Address, + AUDIO_REQ_SetCurrent, AUDIO_EPCONTROL_SamplingFreq, + sizeof(SampleRate), &SampleRate) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Audio Sampling Frequency.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + /* Sample reload timer initialization */ + TIMSK0 = (1 << OCIE0A); + OCR0A = ((F_CPU / 8 / 48000) - 1); + TCCR0A = (1 << WGM01); // CTC mode + TCCR0B = (1 << CS01); // Fcpu/8 speed + + /* Set speaker as output */ + DDRC |= (1 << 6); + + /* PWM speaker timer initialization */ + TCCR3A = ((1 << WGM30) | (1 << COM3A1) | (1 << COM3A0)); // Set on match, clear on TOP + TCCR3B = ((1 << WGM32) | (1 << CS30)); // Fast 8-Bit PWM, F_CPU speed + + puts_P(PSTR("Audio Device Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/AudioInputHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/AudioInputHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dfdc319129 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/AudioInputHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,77 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for AudioInputHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _AUDIO_INPUT_HOST_H_ +#define _AUDIO_INPUT_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/AudioInputHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/AudioInputHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0736e0df47 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/AudioInputHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Audio Input Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Audio Class</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Standard Audio Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Audio 1.0 Class Specification \n + * USBIF Audio 1.0 Class Terminal Types Specification \n + * USBIF Audio 1.0 Data Formats Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Audio Input host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Audio host, for USB Audio devices using + * the USB Audio 1.0 class profile. + * + * Incoming audio will output in 8-bit PWM onto the timer 3 output compare + * channel A, and will also be indicated on the board LEDs. Decouple the PWM + * output with a capacitor and attach to a speaker to hear the audio. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c2daffbdf7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Audio Input Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.class.audio_input.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.class.audio_input"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.class.audio_input" caption="Audio Input Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Audio Input Host demo, implementing a basic USB audio sink that can output incoming audio data to a speaker. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="Audio Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="AudioInputHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="AudioInputHost.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="AudioInputHost.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dda0086588 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Audio Input Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..35294e9642 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioInputHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = AudioInputHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/AudioOutputHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/AudioOutputHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6ef74c3aa9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/AudioOutputHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,243 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the AudioOutputHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "AudioOutputHost.h" + +/** LUFA Audio Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all Audio Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t Speaker_Audio_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .DataOUTPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2), + }, + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Audio Output Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + Audio_Host_USBTask(&Speaker_Audio_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** ISR to handle the reloading of the PWM timer with the next sample. */ +ISR(TIMER0_COMPA_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + uint8_t PrevPipe = Pipe_GetCurrentPipe(); + + /* Check that the USB bus is ready for the next sample to write */ + if (Audio_Host_IsReadyForNextSample(&Speaker_Audio_Interface)) + { + int16_t AudioSample; + + #if defined(USE_TEST_TONE) + static uint8_t SquareWaveSampleCount; + static int16_t CurrentWaveValue; + + /* In test tone mode, generate a square wave at 1/256 of the sample rate */ + if (SquareWaveSampleCount++ == 0xFF) + CurrentWaveValue ^= 0x8000; + + /* Only generate audio if the board button is being pressed */ + AudioSample = (Buttons_GetStatus() & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ? CurrentWaveValue : 0; + #else + /* Audio sample is ADC value scaled to fit the entire range */ + AudioSample = ((SAMPLE_MAX_RANGE / ADC_MAX_RANGE) * ADC_GetResult()); + + #if defined(MICROPHONE_BIASED_TO_HALF_RAIL) + /* Microphone is biased to half rail voltage, subtract the bias from the sample value */ + AudioSample -= (SAMPLE_MAX_RANGE / 2); + #endif + #endif + + Audio_Host_WriteSample16(&Speaker_Audio_Interface, AudioSample); + Audio_Host_WriteSample16(&Speaker_Audio_Interface, AudioSample); + } + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PrevPipe); +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + Buttons_Init(); + ADC_Init(ADC_FREE_RUNNING | ADC_PRESCALE_32); + ADC_SetupChannel(MIC_IN_ADC_CHANNEL); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); + + /* Start the ADC conversion in free running mode */ + ADC_StartReading(ADC_REFERENCE_AVCC | ADC_RIGHT_ADJUSTED | ADC_GET_CHANNEL_MASK(MIC_IN_ADC_CHANNEL)); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Device Attached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize; + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData, + sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData)) != HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Retrieving Configuration Descriptor.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (Audio_Host_ConfigurePipes(&Speaker_Audio_Interface, + ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData) != AUDIO_ENUMERROR_NoError) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Attached Device Not a Valid Audio Output Device.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Device Configuration.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (Audio_Host_StartStopStreaming(&Speaker_Audio_Interface, true) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Enabling Audio Stream.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + USB_Audio_SampleFreq_t SampleRate = AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(48000); + if (Audio_Host_GetSetEndpointProperty(&Speaker_Audio_Interface, Speaker_Audio_Interface.Config.DataOUTPipe.Address, + AUDIO_REQ_SetCurrent, AUDIO_EPCONTROL_SamplingFreq, + sizeof(SampleRate), &SampleRate) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Audio Sampling Frequency.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + /* Sample reload timer initialization */ + TIMSK0 = (1 << OCIE0A); + OCR0A = ((F_CPU / 8 / 48000) - 1); + TCCR0A = (1 << WGM01); // CTC mode + TCCR0B = (1 << CS01); // Fcpu/8 speed + + puts_P(PSTR("Audio Device Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/AudioOutputHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/AudioOutputHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ff8a452d01 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/AudioOutputHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,87 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for AudioOutputHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _AUDIO_OUTPUT_HOST_H_ +#define _AUDIO_OUTPUT_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/ADC.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Maximum audio sample value for the microphone input. */ + #define SAMPLE_MAX_RANGE 0xFFFF + + /** Maximum ADC range for the microphone input. */ + #define ADC_MAX_RANGE 0x3FF + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/AudioOutputHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/AudioOutputHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5e79a33e38 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/AudioOutputHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,83 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Audio Output Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Audio Class</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Standard Audio Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Audio 1.0 Class Specification \n + * USBIF Audio 1.0 Class Terminal Types Specification \n + * USBIF Audio 1.0 Data Formats Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Audio Output host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Audio host, for USB Audio devices using + * the USB Audio 1.0 class profile. + * + * By default, the demo will produce a square wave test tone when the board + * button is pressed. If USE_TEST_TONE is not defined in the project makefile, + * incoming audio from the ADC channel 1 will be sampled and sent to the attached + * USB audio device instead. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MIC_IN_ADC_CHANNEL</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Sets the ADC channel used by the demo for the input audio samples from an attached microphone.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>USE_TEST_TONE</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, this alters the demo to produce a square wave test tone when the first board button is pressed + * instead of sampling the board microphone.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MICROPHONE_BIASED_TO_HALF_RAIL</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, this alters the demo so that the half VCC bias of the microphone input is subtracted.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ff8ed270de --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,51 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define MIC_IN_ADC_CHANNEL 2 + + #define MICROPHONE_BIASED_TO_HALF_RAIL + #define USE_TEST_TONE + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6bd97286bd --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,52 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Audio Output Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.class.audio_output.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.class.audio_output"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.class.audio_output" caption="Audio Output Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Audio Output Host demo, implementing a basic USB audio source that can output audio data to an attached device. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="Audio Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="AudioOutputHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="AudioOutputHost.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="AudioOutputHost.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.adc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c27221c69f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Audio Output Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4d8611b64b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/AudioOutputHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = AudioOutputHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/JoystickHostWithParser.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/JoystickHostWithParser.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0951328599 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/JoystickHostWithParser.c @@ -0,0 +1,286 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the JoystickHostWithParser demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "JoystickHostWithParser.h" + +/** Processed HID report descriptor items structure, containing information on each HID report element */ +static HID_ReportInfo_t HIDReportInfo; + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t Joystick_HID_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .DataINPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .HIDInterfaceProtocol = HID_CSCP_NonBootProtocol, + .HIDParserData = &HIDReportInfo + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Joystick Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + JoystickHost_Task(); + + HID_Host_USBTask(&Joystick_HID_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Task to manage an enumerated USB joystick once connected, to display movement + * data as it is received. + */ +void JoystickHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + if (HID_Host_IsReportReceived(&Joystick_HID_Interface)) + { + uint8_t JoystickReport[Joystick_HID_Interface.State.LargestReportSize]; + HID_Host_ReceiveReport(&Joystick_HID_Interface, &JoystickReport); + + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS; + + for (uint8_t ReportNumber = 0; ReportNumber < HIDReportInfo.TotalReportItems; ReportNumber++) + { + HID_ReportItem_t* ReportItem = &HIDReportInfo.ReportItems[ReportNumber]; + + /* Update the report item value if it is contained within the current report */ + if (!(USB_GetHIDReportItemInfo(JoystickReport, ReportItem))) + continue; + + /* Determine what report item is being tested, process updated value as needed */ + if ((ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_BUTTON) && + (ReportItem->ItemType == HID_REPORT_ITEM_In)) + { + if (ReportItem->Value) + LEDMask = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + else if ((ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_GENERIC_DCTRL) && + ((ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Usage == USAGE_X) || + (ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Usage == USAGE_Y)) && + (ReportItem->ItemType == HID_REPORT_ITEM_In)) + { + int16_t DeltaMovement = HID_ALIGN_DATA(ReportItem, int16_t); + + if (DeltaMovement) + { + if (ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Usage == USAGE_X) + LEDMask |= ((DeltaMovement > 0) ? LEDS_LED1 : LEDS_LED2); + else + LEDMask |= ((DeltaMovement > 0) ? LEDS_LED3 : LEDS_LED4); + } + } + } + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); + } +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Device Attached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize; + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData, + sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData)) != HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Retrieving Configuration Descriptor.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (HID_Host_ConfigurePipes(&Joystick_HID_Interface, + ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData) != HID_ENUMERROR_NoError) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Attached Device Not a Valid Joystick.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Device Configuration.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (HID_Host_SetReportProtocol(&Joystick_HID_Interface) != 0) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Report Protocol Mode or Not a Valid Joystick.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Joystick Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Callback for the HID Report Parser. This function is called each time the HID report parser is about to store + * an IN, OUT or FEATURE item into the HIDReportInfo structure. To save on RAM, we are able to filter out items + * we aren't interested in (preventing us from being able to extract them later on, but saving on the RAM they would + * have occupied). + * + * \param[in] CurrentItem Pointer to the item the HID report parser is currently working with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the item should be stored into the HID report structure, \c false if it should be discarded + */ +bool CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem(HID_ReportItem_t* const CurrentItem) +{ + bool IsJoystick = false; + + /* Iterate through the item's collection path, until either the root collection node or a collection with the + * Joystick Usage is found - this prevents Mice, which use identical descriptors except for the Joystick usage + * parent node, from being erroneously treated as a joystick by the demo + */ + for (HID_CollectionPath_t* CurrPath = CurrentItem->CollectionPath; CurrPath != NULL; CurrPath = CurrPath->Parent) + { + if ((CurrPath->Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_GENERIC_DCTRL) && + (CurrPath->Usage.Usage == USAGE_JOYSTICK)) + { + IsJoystick = true; + break; + } + } + + /* If a collection with the joystick usage was not found, indicate that we are not interested in this item */ + if (!IsJoystick) + return false; + + /* Check the attributes of the current item - see if we are interested in it or not; + * only store BUTTON and GENERIC_DESKTOP_CONTROL items into the Processed HID Report + * structure to save RAM and ignore the rest + */ + return ((CurrentItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_BUTTON) || + (CurrentItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_GENERIC_DCTRL)); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/JoystickHostWithParser.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/JoystickHostWithParser.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..798900ecdc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/JoystickHostWithParser.h @@ -0,0 +1,95 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for JoystickHostWithParser.c. + */ + +#ifndef _JOYSTICK_HOST_H_ +#define _JOYSTICK_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage Page value for a toggle button. */ + #define USAGE_PAGE_BUTTON 0x09 + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage Page value for a Generic Desktop Control. */ + #define USAGE_PAGE_GENERIC_DCTRL 0x01 + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage for a Joystick. */ + #define USAGE_JOYSTICK 0x04 + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage value for a X axis movement. */ + #define USAGE_X 0x30 + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage value for a Y axis movement. */ + #define USAGE_Y 0x31 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void JoystickHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + + bool CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem(HID_ReportItem_t* const CurrentItem); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/JoystickHostWithParser.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/JoystickHostWithParser.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9eba4ed864 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/JoystickHostWithParser.txt @@ -0,0 +1,71 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Joystick Host With HID Descriptor Parser Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Joystick host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Joystick host, for USB joysticks using + * the standard joystick HID profile. It uses a HID parser for the HID + * reports, allowing for correct operation across all USB joysticks. This + * demo supports joysticks with a single HID report. + * + * Joystick movement and button presses are displayed on the board LEDs. + * On connection to a USB joystick, the report items will be processed and + * printed as a formatted list through the USART before the joystick is + * fully enumerated. + * + * Currently only single interface joysticks are supported. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8899d81393 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Joystick HID (with parser) Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.class.joystick_parser.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.class.joystick_parser"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.class.joystick_parser" caption="Joystick HID (with parser) Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Joystick HID Host demo with HID parser, implementing a basic USB joystick host that can display movement data on the board LEDs. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="JoystickHostWithParser.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="JoystickHostWithParser.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="JoystickHostWithParser.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e8f82b8fed --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Joystick Host Demo (Using HID Descriptor Parser)" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cbb44cffcb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/JoystickHostWithParser/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = JoystickHostWithParser +SRC = $(TARGET).c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..57dcdb0ac9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,244 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the KeyboardHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "KeyboardHost.h" + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t Keyboard_HID_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .DataINPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .HIDInterfaceProtocol = HID_CSCP_KeyboardBootProtocol, + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Keyboard Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + KeyboardHost_Task(); + + HID_Host_USBTask(&Keyboard_HID_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Task to manage an enumerated USB keyboard once connected, to display key state + * data as it is received. + */ +void KeyboardHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + if (HID_Host_IsReportReceived(&Keyboard_HID_Interface)) + { + USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t KeyboardReport; + HID_Host_ReceiveReport(&Keyboard_HID_Interface, &KeyboardReport); + + LEDs_ChangeLEDs(LEDS_LED1, (KeyboardReport.Modifier) ? LEDS_LED1 : 0); + + uint8_t KeyCode = KeyboardReport.KeyCode[0]; + + if (KeyCode) + { + char PressedKey = 0; + + LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_LED2); + + /* Retrieve pressed key character if alphanumeric */ + if ((KeyCode >= HID_KEYBOARD_SC_A) && (KeyCode <= HID_KEYBOARD_SC_Z)) + { + PressedKey = (KeyCode - HID_KEYBOARD_SC_A) + 'A'; + } + else if ((KeyCode >= HID_KEYBOARD_SC_1_AND_EXCLAMATION) & + (KeyCode < HID_KEYBOARD_SC_0_AND_CLOSING_PARENTHESIS)) + { + PressedKey = (KeyCode - HID_KEYBOARD_SC_1_AND_EXCLAMATION) + '1'; + } + else if (KeyCode == HID_KEYBOARD_SC_0_AND_CLOSING_PARENTHESIS) + { + PressedKey = '0'; + } + else if (KeyCode == HID_KEYBOARD_SC_SPACE) + { + PressedKey = ' '; + } + else if (KeyCode == HID_KEYBOARD_SC_ENTER) + { + PressedKey = '\n'; + } + + if (PressedKey) + putchar(PressedKey); + } + } +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Device Attached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize; + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData, + sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData)) != HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Retrieving Configuration Descriptor.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (HID_Host_ConfigurePipes(&Keyboard_HID_Interface, + ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData) != HID_ENUMERROR_NoError) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Attached Device Not a Valid Keyboard.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Device Configuration.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (HID_Host_SetBootProtocol(&Keyboard_HID_Interface) != 0) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Could not Set Boot Protocol Mode.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Keyboard Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cf04504a41 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for KeyboardHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _KEYBOARD_HOST_H_ +#define _KEYBOARD_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void KeyboardHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..49cc672a4c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,71 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Keyboard Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification, USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode, Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Keyboard host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB keyboard host, for USB keyboards using + * the standard keyboard HID profile. + * + * Pressed alpha-numeric, enter or space key is transmitted through the serial + * USART at serial settings 9600, 8, N, 1. + * + * This uses a naive method where the keyboard is set to Boot Protocol mode, so + * that the report structure is fixed and known. A better implementation + * uses the HID report parser for correct report data processing across + * all compatible mice with advanced characteristics, as shown in the + * KeyboardHostWithParser demo application. + * + * Currently only single interface keyboards are supported. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..46cd71fe71 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Keyboard HID Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.class.keyboard.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.class.keyboard"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.class.keyboard" caption="Keyboard HID Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Keyboard HID Host demo, implementing a basic USB keyboard host that can display key press data on the board LEDs. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="KeyboardHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="KeyboardHost.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="KeyboardHost.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..968ab03f18 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Keyboard Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f3f34d20d3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = KeyboardHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ac93ab5c3b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.c @@ -0,0 +1,287 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the KeyboardHostWithParser demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "KeyboardHostWithParser.h" + +/** Processed HID report descriptor items structure, containing information on each HID report element */ +static HID_ReportInfo_t HIDReportInfo; + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t Keyboard_HID_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .DataINPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .HIDInterfaceProtocol = HID_CSCP_NonBootProtocol, + .HIDParserData = &HIDReportInfo + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Keyboard Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + KeyboardHost_Task(); + + HID_Host_USBTask(&Keyboard_HID_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Task to manage an enumerated USB keyboard once connected, to display key state + * data as it is received. + */ +void KeyboardHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + if (HID_Host_IsReportReceived(&Keyboard_HID_Interface)) + { + uint8_t KeyboardReport[Keyboard_HID_Interface.State.LargestReportSize]; + HID_Host_ReceiveReport(&Keyboard_HID_Interface, &KeyboardReport); + + for (uint8_t ReportNumber = 0; ReportNumber < HIDReportInfo.TotalReportItems; ReportNumber++) + { + HID_ReportItem_t* ReportItem = &HIDReportInfo.ReportItems[ReportNumber]; + + /* Update the report item value if it is contained within the current report */ + if (!(USB_GetHIDReportItemInfo(KeyboardReport, ReportItem))) + continue; + + /* Determine what report item is being tested, process updated value as needed */ + if ((ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_KEYBOARD) && + (ReportItem->Attributes.BitSize == 8) && + (ReportItem->Attributes.Logical.Maximum > 1) && + (ReportItem->ItemType == HID_REPORT_ITEM_In)) + { + /* Key code is an unsigned char in length, cast to the appropriate type */ + uint8_t KeyCode = (uint8_t)ReportItem->Value; + + /* If scan-code is non-zero, a key is being pressed */ + if (KeyCode) + { + /* Toggle status LED to indicate keypress */ + LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_LED2); + + char PressedKey = 0; + + /* Convert scan-code to printable character if alphanumeric */ + if ((KeyCode >= HID_KEYBOARD_SC_A) && (KeyCode <= HID_KEYBOARD_SC_Z)) + { + PressedKey = (KeyCode - HID_KEYBOARD_SC_A) + 'A'; + } + else if ((KeyCode >= HID_KEYBOARD_SC_1_AND_EXCLAMATION) & + (KeyCode < HID_KEYBOARD_SC_0_AND_CLOSING_PARENTHESIS)) + { + PressedKey = (KeyCode - HID_KEYBOARD_SC_1_AND_EXCLAMATION) + '1'; + } + else if (KeyCode == HID_KEYBOARD_SC_0_AND_CLOSING_PARENTHESIS) + { + PressedKey = '0'; + } + else if (KeyCode == HID_KEYBOARD_SC_SPACE) + { + PressedKey = ' '; + } + else if (KeyCode == HID_KEYBOARD_SC_ENTER) + { + PressedKey = '\n'; + } + + /* Print the pressed key character out through the serial port if valid */ + if (PressedKey) + putchar(PressedKey); + } + + /* Once a scan-code is found, stop scanning through the report items */ + break; + } + } + } +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Device Attached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize; + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData, + sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData)) != HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Retrieving Configuration Descriptor.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (HID_Host_ConfigurePipes(&Keyboard_HID_Interface, + ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData) != HID_ENUMERROR_NoError) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Attached Device Not a Valid Keyboard.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Device Configuration.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (HID_Host_SetReportProtocol(&Keyboard_HID_Interface) != 0) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Report Protocol Mode or Not a Valid Keyboard.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Keyboard Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Callback for the HID Report Parser. This function is called each time the HID report parser is about to store + * an IN, OUT or FEATURE item into the HIDReportInfo structure. To save on RAM, we are able to filter out items + * we aren't interested in (preventing us from being able to extract them later on, but saving on the RAM they would + * have occupied). + * + * \param[in] CurrentItem Pointer to the item the HID report parser is currently working with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the item should be stored into the HID report structure, \c false if it should be discarded + */ +bool CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem(HID_ReportItem_t* const CurrentItem) +{ + /* Check the attributes of the current item - see if we are interested in it or not; + * only store KEYBOARD usage page items into the Processed HID Report structure to + * save RAM and ignore the rest + */ + return (CurrentItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_KEYBOARD); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2d2a27b09f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.h @@ -0,0 +1,83 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for KeyboardHostWithParser.c. + */ + +#ifndef _KEYBOARD_HOST_H_ +#define _KEYBOARD_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage Page value for a desktop keyboard. */ + #define USAGE_PAGE_KEYBOARD 0x07 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void KeyboardHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + + bool CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem(HID_ReportItem_t* const CurrentItem); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4c87965ca4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.txt @@ -0,0 +1,71 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Keyboard Host With HID Descriptor Parser Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Keyboard host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Keyboard host, for USB keyboards using + * the standard Keyboard HID profile. It uses a HID parser for the HID reports, + * allowing for correct operation across all USB keyboards. This demo supports + * keyboards with a single HID report. + * + * Pressed alpha-numeric, enter or space key is transmitted through the serial + * USART at serial settings 9600, 8, N, 1. On connection to a USB keyboard, the + * report items will be processed and printed as a formatted list through the + * USART before the keyboard is fully enumerated. + * + * Currently only single interface keyboards are supported. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..924299f2fe --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Keyboard HID (with parser) Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.class.keyboard_parser.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.class.keyboard_parser"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.class.keyboard_parser" caption="Keyboard HID (with parser) Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Keyboard HID Host demo with HID parser, implementing a basic USB keyboard host that can display key press data on the board LEDs. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="KeyboardHostWithParser.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="KeyboardHostWithParser.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="KeyboardHostWithParser.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..084a65242f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Keyboard Host Demo (Using HID Descriptor Parser)" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f14d332a3f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/KeyboardHostWithParser/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = KeyboardHostWithParser +SRC = $(TARGET).c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/MIDIHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/MIDIHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a220eae645 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/MIDIHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,272 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the MIDIHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "MIDIHost.h" + +/** LUFA MIDI Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all MIDI Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Host_t Keyboard_MIDI_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .DataINPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2), + .Banks = 1, + }, + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "MIDI Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + JoystickHost_Task(); + + MIDI_Host_USBTask(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + Buttons_Init(); + Joystick_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Task to manage an enumerated USB MIDI device once connected, to display received + * note events from the host and send note changes in response to the board's joystick. + */ +void JoystickHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + MIDI_EventPacket_t MIDIEvent; + while (MIDI_Host_ReceiveEventPacket(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface, &MIDIEvent)) + { + bool NoteOnEvent = (MIDIEvent.Event == MIDI_EVENT(0, MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON)); + bool NoteOffEvent = (MIDIEvent.Event == MIDI_EVENT(0, MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF)); + + /* Display note events from the host */ + if (NoteOnEvent || NoteOffEvent) + { + printf_P(PSTR("MIDI Note %s - Channel %d, Pitch %d, Velocity %d\r\n"), NoteOnEvent ? "On" : "Off", + ((MIDIEvent.Data1 & 0x0F) + 1), + MIDIEvent.Data2, MIDIEvent.Data3); + } + } + + CheckJoystickMovement(); +} + +/** Checks for movement of the board's joystick, and sends corresponding MIDI note on/off + * messages to the host. + */ +void CheckJoystickMovement(void) +{ + static uint8_t PrevJoystickStatus; + + uint8_t MIDICommand = 0; + uint8_t MIDIPitch; + + /* Get current joystick mask, XOR with previous to detect joystick changes */ + uint8_t JoystickStatus = Joystick_GetStatus(); + uint8_t JoystickChanges = (JoystickStatus ^ PrevJoystickStatus); + + /* Get board button status - if pressed use channel 10 (percussion), otherwise use channel 1 */ + uint8_t Channel = ((Buttons_GetStatus() & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ? MIDI_CHANNEL(10) : MIDI_CHANNEL(1)); + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_LEFT) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_LEFT)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3C; + } + else if (JoystickChanges & JOY_UP) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_UP)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3D; + } + else if (JoystickChanges & JOY_RIGHT) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_RIGHT)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3E; + } + else if (JoystickChanges & JOY_DOWN) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_DOWN)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3F; + } + else if (JoystickChanges & JOY_PRESS) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_PRESS)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3B; + } + + if (MIDICommand) + { + MIDI_EventPacket_t MIDIEvent = (MIDI_EventPacket_t) + { + .Event = MIDI_EVENT(0, MIDICommand), + + .Data1 = MIDICommand | Channel, + .Data2 = MIDIPitch, + .Data3 = MIDI_STANDARD_VELOCITY, + }; + + MIDI_Host_SendEventPacket(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface, &MIDIEvent); + MIDI_Host_Flush(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface); + } + + PrevJoystickStatus = JoystickStatus; +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Device Attached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize; + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData, + sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData)) != HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Retrieving Configuration Descriptor.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (MIDI_Host_ConfigurePipes(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface, + ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData) != MIDI_ENUMERROR_NoError) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Attached Device Not a Valid MIDI Class Device.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Device Configuration.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("MIDI Device Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/MIDIHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/MIDIHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6667716bae --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/MIDIHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,81 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for MIDIHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MIDI_HOST_H_ +#define _MIDI_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void CheckJoystickMovement(void); + void JoystickHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/MIDIHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/MIDIHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..33a8319f06 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/MIDIHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,60 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage MIDI Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Audio Class Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>MIDI Subclass</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF USB MIDI Audio Class Standard</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * MIDI host demonstration application. This demo will enumerate an attached USB-MIDI device, and print incoming MIDI note + * on and off messages on any channel to the serial port. Pressing the board joystick will send note on and off messages to + * the attached MIDI device, with the board HWB controlling the note channel. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..140c03ba72 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="MIDI Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.class.midi.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.class.midi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.class.midi" caption="MIDI Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ MIDI Host demo, capable of sending and receiving MIDI messages to and from an attached device. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="MIDI Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="MIDIHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="MIDIHost.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="MIDIHost.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7a6906a271 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - MIDI Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2ed4e4bd57 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MIDIHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = MIDIHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e2b5166f25 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY + #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS 5000 +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..62a4071c3d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,311 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the MassStorageHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "MassStorageHost.h" + +/** LUFA Mass Storage Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all Mass Storage Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t FlashDisk_MS_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .DataINPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2), + .Banks = 1, + }, + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Mass Storage Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + MassStorageHost_Task(); + + MS_Host_USBTask(&FlashDisk_MS_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Task to manage an enumerated USB Mass Storage device once connected, to print out + * data from the device. + */ +void MassStorageHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + + puts_P(PSTR("Waiting until ready...\r\n")); + + for (;;) + { + uint8_t ErrorCode = MS_Host_TestUnitReady(&FlashDisk_MS_Interface, 0); + + if (!(ErrorCode)) + break; + + /* Check if an error other than a logical command error (device busy) received */ + if (ErrorCode != MS_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error waiting for device to be ready.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Retrieving Capacity...\r\n")); + + SCSI_Capacity_t DiskCapacity; + if (MS_Host_ReadDeviceCapacity(&FlashDisk_MS_Interface, 0, &DiskCapacity)) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error retrieving device capacity.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + printf_P(PSTR("%lu blocks of %lu bytes.\r\n"), DiskCapacity.Blocks, DiskCapacity.BlockSize); + + uint8_t BlockBuffer[DiskCapacity.BlockSize]; + + if (MS_Host_ReadDeviceBlocks(&FlashDisk_MS_Interface, 0, 0x00000000, 1, DiskCapacity.BlockSize, BlockBuffer)) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error reading device block.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("\r\nContents of first block:\r\n")); + + for (uint16_t Chunk = 0; Chunk < (DiskCapacity.BlockSize >> 4); Chunk++) + { + uint8_t* ChunkPtr = &BlockBuffer[Chunk << 4]; + + /* Print out the 16 bytes of the chunk in HEX format */ + for (uint8_t ByteOffset = 0; ByteOffset < (1 << 4); ByteOffset++) + { + char CurrByte = *(ChunkPtr + ByteOffset); + printf_P(PSTR("%.2X "), CurrByte); + } + + printf_P(PSTR(" ")); + + /* Print out the 16 bytes of the chunk in ASCII format */ + for (uint8_t ByteOffset = 0; ByteOffset < (1 << 4); ByteOffset++) + { + char CurrByte = *(ChunkPtr + ByteOffset); + putchar(isprint(CurrByte) ? CurrByte : '.'); + } + + printf_P(PSTR("\r\n")); + } + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Device Attached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize; + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData, + sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData)) != HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Retrieving Configuration Descriptor.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (MS_Host_ConfigurePipes(&FlashDisk_MS_Interface, + ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData) != MS_ENUMERROR_NoError) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Attached Device Not a Valid Mass Storage Device.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Device Configuration.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + uint8_t MaxLUNIndex; + if (MS_Host_GetMaxLUN(&FlashDisk_MS_Interface, &MaxLUNIndex)) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error retrieving max LUN index.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + printf_P(PSTR("Total LUNs: %d - Using first LUN in device.\r\n"), (MaxLUNIndex + 1)); + + if (MS_Host_ResetMSInterface(&FlashDisk_MS_Interface)) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error resetting Mass Storage interface.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t SenseData; + if (MS_Host_RequestSense(&FlashDisk_MS_Interface, 0, &SenseData) != 0) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error retrieving device sense.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + if (MS_Host_PreventAllowMediumRemoval(&FlashDisk_MS_Interface, 0, true)) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error setting Prevent Device Removal bit.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t InquiryData; + if (MS_Host_GetInquiryData(&FlashDisk_MS_Interface, 0, &InquiryData)) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error retrieving device Inquiry data.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + printf_P(PSTR("Vendor \"%.8s\", Product \"%.16s\"\r\n"), InquiryData.VendorID, InquiryData.ProductID); + + puts_P(PSTR("Mass Storage Device Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..088f5c1400 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for MassStorage.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MASS_STORAGE_HOST_H_ +#define _MASS_STORAGE_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <ctype.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void MassStorageHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4b07261c4f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,68 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Mass Storage Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Mass Storage Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Bulk Only</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Mass Storage Standard \n + * USB Bulk-Only Transport Standard \n + * SCSI Primary Commands Specification \n + * SCSI Block Commands Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Mass Storage host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Mass Storage host, for USB storage devices + * using the standard Mass Storage USB profile. + * + * The first 512 bytes (boot sector) of an attached disk's memory will be dumped + * out of the serial port in HEX and ASCII form when it is attached to the AT90USB1287 + * AVR. The device will then wait for HWB to be pressed, whereupon the entire ASCII contents + * of the disk will be dumped to the serial port. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..54bfe50cc6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Mass Storage Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.class.ms.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.class.ms"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.class.ms" caption="Mass Storage Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Mass Storage Host demo, capable of reading and writing raw 512 byte segments to the device's serial port. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="Mass Storage Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="MassStorageHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="MassStorageHost.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="MassStorageHost.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..58657165ca --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Mass Storage Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2423ff4ca7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MassStorageHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = MassStorageHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/MouseHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/MouseHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ffcdc4754f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/MouseHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,227 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the MouseHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "MouseHost.h" + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t Mouse_HID_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .DataINPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .HIDInterfaceProtocol = HID_CSCP_MouseBootProtocol, + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Mouse Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + MouseHost_Task(); + + HID_Host_USBTask(&Mouse_HID_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Task to manage an enumerated USB mouse once connected, to display movement + * data as it is received. + */ +void MouseHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + if (HID_Host_IsReportReceived(&Mouse_HID_Interface)) + { + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS; + + USB_MouseReport_Data_t MouseReport; + HID_Host_ReceiveReport(&Mouse_HID_Interface, &MouseReport); + + printf_P(PSTR("dX:%2d dY:%2d Button:%d\r\n"), MouseReport.X, + MouseReport.Y, + MouseReport.Button); + if (MouseReport.X > 0) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED1; + else if (MouseReport.X < 0) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED2; + + if (MouseReport.Y > 0) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED3; + else if (MouseReport.Y < 0) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED4; + + if (MouseReport.Button) + LEDMask = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); + } +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Device Attached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize; + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData, + sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData)) != HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Retrieving Configuration Descriptor.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (HID_Host_ConfigurePipes(&Mouse_HID_Interface, + ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData) != HID_ENUMERROR_NoError) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Attached Device Not a Valid Mouse.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Device Configuration.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (HID_Host_SetBootProtocol(&Mouse_HID_Interface) != 0) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Could not Set Boot Protocol Mode.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Mouse Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/MouseHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/MouseHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e167e0b788 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/MouseHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for MouseHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MOUSE_HOST_H_ +#define _MOUSE_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void MouseHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/MouseHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/MouseHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..29364537b2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/MouseHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,74 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Mouse Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Mouse host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Mouse host, for USB mice using + * the standard mouse HID profile. + * + * Mouse movement and button presses are displayed on the board LEDs, + * as well as printed out the serial terminal as formatted dY, dY and + * button status information. + * + * This uses a naive method where the mouse is set to Boot Protocol mode, so + * that the report structure is fixed and known. A better implementation + * uses the HID report parser for correct report data processing across + * all compatible mice with advanced characteristics, as shown in the + * MouseHostWithParser demo application. + * + * Currently only single interface mice are supported. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b28860771a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Mouse HID Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.class.mouse.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.class.mouse"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.class.mouse" caption="Mouse HID Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Mouse HID Host demo, implementing a basic USB mouse host that can display movement data on the board LEDs. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="MouseHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="MouseHost.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="MouseHost.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a025dd58d9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Mouse Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..feb16f5835 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = MouseHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e4d8a0f08f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.c @@ -0,0 +1,300 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the MouseHostWithParser demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "MouseHostWithParser.h" + +/** Processed HID report descriptor items structure, containing information on each HID report element */ +static HID_ReportInfo_t HIDReportInfo; + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t Mouse_HID_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .DataINPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .HIDInterfaceProtocol = HID_CSCP_NonBootProtocol, + .HIDParserData = &HIDReportInfo + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Mouse Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + MouseHost_Task(); + + HID_Host_USBTask(&Mouse_HID_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Task to manage an enumerated USB mouse once connected, to display movement + * data as it is received. + */ +void MouseHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + if (HID_Host_IsReportReceived(&Mouse_HID_Interface)) + { + uint8_t MouseReport[Mouse_HID_Interface.State.LargestReportSize]; + HID_Host_ReceiveReport(&Mouse_HID_Interface, &MouseReport); + + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS; + + for (uint8_t ReportNumber = 0; ReportNumber < HIDReportInfo.TotalReportItems; ReportNumber++) + { + HID_ReportItem_t* ReportItem = &HIDReportInfo.ReportItems[ReportNumber]; + + /* Update the report item value if it is contained within the current report */ + if (!(USB_GetHIDReportItemInfo(MouseReport, ReportItem))) + continue; + + /* Determine what report item is being tested, process updated value as needed */ + if ((ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_BUTTON) && + (ReportItem->ItemType == HID_REPORT_ITEM_In)) + { + /* Buttons are numbered sequentially in their HID usages, button 1 is the left mouse button */ + uint8_t ButtonID = ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Usage; + + if ((ButtonID == 1) && (ReportItem->Value != 0)) + LEDMask = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + else if ((ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_GENERIC_DCTRL) && + (ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Usage == USAGE_SCROLL_WHEEL) && + (ReportItem->ItemType == HID_REPORT_ITEM_In)) + { + /* Convert wheel data to a 16-bit signed value */ + int16_t WheelDelta = HID_ALIGN_DATA(ReportItem, int16_t); + + if (WheelDelta) + LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | ((WheelDelta > 0) ? LEDS_LED3 : LEDS_LED4)); + } + else if ((ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_GENERIC_DCTRL) && + ((ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Usage == USAGE_X) || + (ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Usage == USAGE_Y)) && + (ReportItem->ItemType == HID_REPORT_ITEM_In)) + { + /* Convert X/Y movement to 16-bit signed value */ + int16_t DeltaMovement = HID_ALIGN_DATA(ReportItem, int16_t); + + if (DeltaMovement) + { + if (ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Usage == USAGE_X) + LEDMask |= ((DeltaMovement > 0) ? LEDS_LED1 : LEDS_LED2); + else + LEDMask |= ((DeltaMovement > 0) ? LEDS_LED3 : LEDS_LED4); + } + } + } + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); + } +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Device Attached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize; + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData, + sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData)) != HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Retrieving Configuration Descriptor.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (HID_Host_ConfigurePipes(&Mouse_HID_Interface, + ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData) != HID_ENUMERROR_NoError) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Attached Device Not a Valid Mouse.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Device Configuration.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (HID_Host_SetReportProtocol(&Mouse_HID_Interface) != 0) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Report Protocol Mode or Not a Valid Mouse.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Mouse Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Callback for the HID Report Parser. This function is called each time the HID report parser is about to store + * an IN, OUT or FEATURE item into the HIDReportInfo structure. To save on RAM, we are able to filter out items + * we aren't interested in (preventing us from being able to extract them later on, but saving on the RAM they would + * have occupied). + * + * \param[in] CurrentItem Pointer to the item the HID report parser is currently working with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the item should be stored into the HID report structure, \c false if it should be discarded + */ +bool CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem(HID_ReportItem_t* const CurrentItem) +{ + bool IsMouse = false; + + /* Iterate through the item's collection path, until either the root collection node or a collection with the + * Mouse Usage is found - this prevents Joysticks, which use identical descriptors except for the Joystick usage + * parent node, from being erroneously treated as a mouse by the demo + */ + for (HID_CollectionPath_t* CurrPath = CurrentItem->CollectionPath; CurrPath != NULL; CurrPath = CurrPath->Parent) + { + if ((CurrPath->Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_GENERIC_DCTRL) && + (CurrPath->Usage.Usage == USAGE_MOUSE)) + { + IsMouse = true; + break; + } + } + + /* If a collection with the mouse usage was not found, indicate that we are not interested in this item */ + if (!IsMouse) + return false; + + /* Check the attributes of the current item - see if we are interested in it or not; + * only store BUTTON and GENERIC_DESKTOP_CONTROL items into the Processed HID Report + * structure to save RAM and ignore the rest + */ + return ((CurrentItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_BUTTON) || + (CurrentItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_GENERIC_DCTRL)); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2ec1348eaa --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.h @@ -0,0 +1,98 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for MouseHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MOUSE_HOST_H_ +#define _MOUSE_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage Page value for a toggle button. */ + #define USAGE_PAGE_BUTTON 0x09 + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage Page value for a Generic Desktop Control. */ + #define USAGE_PAGE_GENERIC_DCTRL 0x01 + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage for a Mouse. */ + #define USAGE_MOUSE 0x02 + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage value for a X axis movement. */ + #define USAGE_X 0x30 + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage value for a Y axis movement. */ + #define USAGE_Y 0x31 + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage value for a Scroll Wheel movement. */ + #define USAGE_SCROLL_WHEEL 0x38 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void MouseHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + + bool CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem(HID_ReportItem_t* const CurrentItem); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9b1b7d055c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.txt @@ -0,0 +1,71 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Mouse Host With HID Descriptor Parser Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Mouse host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Mouse host, for USB mice using + * the standard mouse HID profile. It uses a HID parser for the HID + * reports, allowing for correct operation across all USB mice. This + * demo supports mice with a single HID report. + * + * Mouse and scroll wheel movement and button presses are displayed + * on the board LEDs. On connection to a USB mouse, the report items + * will be processed and printed as a formatted list through the USART + * before the mouse is fully enumerated. + * + * Currently only single interface mice are supported. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..220eb457ca --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Mouse HID (with parser) Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.class.mouse_parser.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.class.mouse_parser"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.class.mouse_parser" caption="Mouse HID (with parser) Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Mouse HID Host demo with HID parser, implementing a basic USB mouse host that can display movement data on the board LEDs. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="MouseHostWithParser.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="MouseHostWithParser.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="MouseHostWithParser.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f12fda279d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Mouse Host Demo (Using HID Descriptor Parser)" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7df0417ecb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/MouseHostWithParser/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = MouseHostWithParser +SRC = $(TARGET).c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/PrinterHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/PrinterHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..499204fc26 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/PrinterHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,234 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the PrinterHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "PrinterHost.h" + +/** LUFA Printer Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all Printer Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t Printer_PRNT_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .DataINPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2), + .Banks = 1, + }, + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Printer Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + PrinterHost_Task(); + + PRNT_Host_USBTask(&Printer_PRNT_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Task to manage an enumerated USB printer once connected, to display device + * information and print a test PCL page. + */ +void PrinterHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + + puts_P(PSTR("Retrieving Device ID...\r\n")); + + char DeviceIDString[300]; + if (PRNT_Host_GetDeviceID(&Printer_PRNT_Interface, DeviceIDString, + sizeof(DeviceIDString)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Getting Device ID.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + printf_P(PSTR("Device ID: %s.\r\n"), DeviceIDString); + + char TestPageData[] = "\033%-12345X\033E" "LUFA PCL Test Page" "\033E\033%-12345X"; + uint16_t TestPageLength = strlen(TestPageData); + + printf_P(PSTR("Sending Test Page (%d bytes)...\r\n"), TestPageLength); + + if (PRNT_Host_SendData(&Printer_PRNT_Interface, &TestPageData, TestPageLength) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Sending Page Data.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Test Page Sent.\r\n")); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Device Attached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize; + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData, + sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData)) != HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Retrieving Configuration Descriptor.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (PRNT_Host_ConfigurePipes(&Printer_PRNT_Interface, + ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData) != PRNT_ENUMERROR_NoError) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Attached Device Not a Valid Printer Class Device.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Device Configuration.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (PRNT_Host_SetBidirectionalMode(&Printer_PRNT_Interface) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Bidirectional Mode.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Printer Device Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/PrinterHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/PrinterHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a05e727e75 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/PrinterHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,81 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for PrinterHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _PRINTER_HOST_H_ +#define _PRINTER_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void PrinterHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/PrinterHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/PrinterHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e2a4820583 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/PrinterHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Printer Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Printer Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Bidirectional Protocol</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Printer Class Specification \n + * PCL Language Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Printer host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Printer host, for USB printers using + * the bidirectional data encapsulation protocol and PCL language. + * + * Upon connection of a compatible printer, the printer's device ID is sent + * to the AVR's serial port, and a simple test page is printed using the PCL + * printer language. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bd355cf35e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Printer Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.class.printer.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.class.printer"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.class.printer" caption="Printer Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Printer Host demo, implementing a basic USB printer host that can send raw printer control data to an attached device. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="Printer Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="PrinterHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="PrinterHost.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="PrinterHost.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3fcf03b2b9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Printer Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0d63256088 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/PrinterHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = PrinterHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/RNDISEthernetHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/RNDISEthernetHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..21afed3386 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/RNDISEthernetHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,253 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the RNDISEthernetHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "RNDISEthernetHost.h" + +/** Buffer to hold incoming and outgoing Ethernet packets. */ +static int8_t PacketBuffer[1024]; + +/** LUFA RNDIS Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all RNDIS Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .DataINPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .NotificationPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 3), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .HostMaxPacketSize = sizeof(PacketBuffer), + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "RNDIS Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + sei(); + + for (;;) + { + RNDISHost_Task(); + + RNDIS_Host_USBTask(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Task to manage an enumerated USB RNDIS device once connected, to display device + * received data packets. + */ +void RNDISHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + if (RNDIS_Host_IsPacketReceived(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface)) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + + uint16_t PacketLength; + RNDIS_Host_ReadPacket(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface, &PacketBuffer, &PacketLength); + + printf_P(PSTR("***PACKET (Size %d)***\r\n"), PacketLength); + + for (uint16_t i = 0; i < PacketLength; i++) + printf("0x%02x ", PacketBuffer[i]); + + printf_P(PSTR("\r\n\r\n")); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Device Attached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize; + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData, + sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData)) != HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Retrieving Configuration Descriptor.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (RNDIS_Host_ConfigurePipes(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface, + ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData) != RNDIS_ENUMERROR_NoError) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Attached Device Not a Valid RNDIS Class Device.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Device Configuration.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (RNDIS_Host_InitializeDevice(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Initializing Device.\r\n")); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + printf_P(PSTR("Device Max Transfer Size: %lu bytes.\r\n"), Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface.State.DeviceMaxPacketSize); + + uint32_t PacketFilter = (REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_DIRECTED | REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_BROADCAST | REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_ALL_MULTICAST); + if (RNDIS_Host_SetRNDISProperty(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface, OID_GEN_CURRENT_PACKET_FILTER, + &PacketFilter, sizeof(PacketFilter)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Device Packet Filter.\r\n")); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + uint32_t VendorID; + if (RNDIS_Host_QueryRNDISProperty(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface, OID_GEN_VENDOR_ID, + &VendorID, sizeof(VendorID)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Getting Vendor ID.\r\n")); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + printf_P(PSTR("Device Vendor ID: 0x%08lX\r\n"), VendorID); + + puts_P(PSTR("RNDIS Device Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/RNDISEthernetHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/RNDISEthernetHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c6fd1a4301 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/RNDISEthernetHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,81 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for RNDISEthernetHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _RNDIS_HOST_H_ +#define _RNDIS_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void RNDISHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/RNDISEthernetHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/RNDISEthernetHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e9edd6d668 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/RNDISEthernetHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,63 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage RNDIS Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Remote NDIS (Microsoft Proprietary CDC Class Networking Standard)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>Microsoft RNDIS Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * RNDIS host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a RNDIS Ethernet host, for USB devices such as + * modems. + * + * This demo will enumerate an attached USB RNDIS device, print out its vendor ID + * and any received packets in raw form through the serial USART. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..37cedaaa53 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="RNDIS Ethernet Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.class.rndis.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.class.rndis"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.class.rndis" caption="RNDIS Ethernet Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Microsoft RNDIS Ethernet Host demo, implementing a RNDIS host that can send and receive Ethernet data to and from an attached device. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="RNDIS Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="RNDISEthernetHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="RNDISEthernetHost.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="RNDISEthernetHost.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6f97bee2c0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - RNDIS Ethernet Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b959ece429 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/RNDISEthernetHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = RNDISEthernetHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fc0c4fa9a9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,230 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the StillImageHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "StillImageHost.h" + +/** LUFA Still Image Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all Still Image Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t DigitalCamera_SI_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .DataINPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .EventsPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 3), + .Banks = 1, + }, + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Still Image Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + StillImageHost_Task(); + + SI_Host_USBTask(&DigitalCamera_SI_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Task to manage an enumerated USB Still Image device once connected, to manage a + * new PIMA session in order to send commands to the attached device. + */ +void StillImageHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + puts_P(PSTR("Opening Session...\r\n")); + + if (SI_Host_OpenSession(&DigitalCamera_SI_Interface) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Could not open PIMA session.\r\n")); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Turning off Device...\r\n")); + + SI_Host_SendCommand(&DigitalCamera_SI_Interface, 0x1013, 0, NULL); + if (SI_Host_ReceiveResponse(&DigitalCamera_SI_Interface)) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Could not turn off device.\r\n")); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Device Off.\r\n")); + + puts_P(PSTR("Closing Session...\r\n")); + + if (SI_Host_CloseSession(&DigitalCamera_SI_Interface) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Could not close PIMA session.\r\n")); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Device Attached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize; + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData, + sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData)) != HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Retrieving Configuration Descriptor.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (SI_Host_ConfigurePipes(&DigitalCamera_SI_Interface, + ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData) != SI_ENUMERROR_NoError) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Attached Device Not a Valid Still Image Class Device.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Device Configuration.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Still Image Device Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..00d966fad1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for StillImageHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _STILL_IMAGE_HOST_H_ +#define _STILL_IMAGE_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void StillImageHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..193228a207 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,65 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Still Image Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Still Image Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Still Image Class Specification \n + * PIMA 15740 Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Still Image host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a Still Image host, for USB devices such as + * digital cameras. + * + * This demo will enumerate an attached USB Still Image device, print out its + * information structure, open a session with the device and finally close the + * session. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4a5f6bfeb1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Still Image Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.class.si.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.class.si"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.class.si" caption="Still Image Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Still Image Host demo, implementing a Still Image host that can send and receive PIMA data to and from an attached device. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="Still Image Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="StillImageHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="StillImageHost.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="StillImageHost.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7eca05a943 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Still Image Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b3d044aa10 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/StillImageHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = StillImageHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/VirtualSerialHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/VirtualSerialHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..740f285f6b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/VirtualSerialHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,217 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the VirtualSerialHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "VirtualSerialHost.h" + +/** LUFA CDC Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all CDC Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .DataINPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .NotificationPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 3), + .Banks = 1, + }, + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "CDC Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + CDCHost_Task(); + + CDC_Host_USBTask(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Task to manage an enumerated USB CDC device once connected, to print received data + * from the device to the serial port. + */ +void CDCHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + if (CDC_Host_BytesReceived(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface)) + { + /* Echo received bytes from the attached device through the USART */ + int16_t ReceivedByte = CDC_Host_ReceiveByte(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + if (!(ReceivedByte < 0)) + putchar(ReceivedByte); + } +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Device Attached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize; + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData, + sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData)) != HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Retrieving Configuration Descriptor.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (CDC_Host_ConfigurePipes(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface, + ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData) != CDC_ENUMERROR_NoError) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Attached Device Not a Valid CDC Class Device.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Device Configuration.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface.State.LineEncoding.BaudRateBPS = 9600; + VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface.State.LineEncoding.CharFormat = CDC_LINEENCODING_OneStopBit; + VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface.State.LineEncoding.ParityType = CDC_PARITY_None; + VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface.State.LineEncoding.DataBits = 8; + + if (CDC_Host_SetLineEncoding(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface)) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Device Line Encoding.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("CDC Device Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/VirtualSerialHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/VirtualSerialHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a2f8fd7145 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/VirtualSerialHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for VirtualSerialHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _VIRTUALSERIAL_HOST_H_ +#define _VIRTUALSERIAL_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void CDCHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/VirtualSerialHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/VirtualSerialHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1e1f9f1ae2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/VirtualSerialHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage CDC Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Abstract Control Model (ACM)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF CDC Class Standard</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * CDC host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference application + * for implementing a USB CDC host, for CDC devices using the standard ACM profile. + * + * This demo prints out received CDC data through the serial port. + * + * Note that this demo is only compatible with devices which report the correct CDC + * and ACM class, subclass and protocol values. Most USB-Serial cables have vendor + * specific features, thus use vendor-specific class/subclass/protocol codes to force + * the user to use specialized drivers. This demo is not compatible with such devices. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e456c9295a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Virtual Serial CDC Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.class.cdc.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.class.cdc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.class.cdc" caption="Virtual Serial CDC Host Demo (Class Driver APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Virtual Serial Host demo, implementing a CDC host that can send and receive data to and from an attached device. This demo uses the user-friendly USB Class Driver APIs to provide a simple, abstracted interface into the USB stack.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="CDC Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="VirtualSerialHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="VirtualSerialHost.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="VirtualSerialHost.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..df50a03e9e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Virtual Serial Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..57cf89a358 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/VirtualSerialHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = VirtualSerialHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..90c1562194 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/ClassDriver/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,46 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +# Makefile to build all the LUFA Host Demos. Call with "make all" to +# rebuild all Host demos. + +# Projects are pre-cleaned before each one is built, to ensure any +# custom LUFA library build options are reflected in the compiled +# code. + +PROJECT_DIRECTORIES := $(shell ls -d */) + +# This makefile is potentially infinitely recursive if something really bad +# happens when determining the set of project directories - hard-abort if +# more than 10 levels deep to avoid angry emails. +ifeq ($(MAKELEVEL), 10) + $(error EMERGENCY ABORT: INFINITE RECURSION DETECTED) +endif + +# Need to special-case building without a per-project object directory +ifeq ($(OBJDIR),) + # If no target specified, force "clean all" and disallow parallel build + ifeq ($(MAKECMDGOALS),) + MAKECMDGOALS := clean all + .NOTPARALLEL: + endif + + # If one of the targets is to build, force "clean" beforehand and disallow parallel build + ifneq ($(findstring all, $(MAKECMDGOALS)),) + MAKECMDGOALS := clean $(MAKECMDGOALS) + .NOTPARALLEL: + endif +endif + +%: $(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES) + @echo . > /dev/null + +$(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES): + @$(MAKE) -C $@ $(MAKECMDGOALS) + +.PHONY: $(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES) diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidAccessoryHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidAccessoryHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..63d94f78ca --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidAccessoryHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,263 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the AndroidAccessoryHost demo. This file contains the main tasks + * of the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "AndroidAccessoryHost.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Android Accessory Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + AndroidHost_Task(); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Task to set the configuration of the attached device after it has been enumerated. */ +void AndroidHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Select the data IN pipe */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(ANDROID_DATA_IN_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Check to see if a packet has been received */ + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + { + /* Re-freeze IN pipe after the packet has been received */ + Pipe_Freeze(); + + /* Check if data is in the pipe */ + if (Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed()) + { + uint8_t NextReceivedByte = Pipe_Read_8(); + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS; + + if (NextReceivedByte & 0x01) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED1; + + if (NextReceivedByte & 0x02) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED2; + + if (NextReceivedByte & 0x04) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED3; + + if (NextReceivedByte & 0x08) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED4; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); + } + else + { + /* Clear the pipe after all data in the packet has been read, ready for the next packet */ + Pipe_ClearIN(); + } + } + + /* Re-freeze IN pipe after use */ + Pipe_Freeze(); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Attached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Getting Device Data.\r\n")); + + /* Get and process the configuration descriptor data */ + uint8_t ErrorCode = ProcessDeviceDescriptor(); + + bool RequiresModeSwitch = (ErrorCode == NonAccessoryModeAndroidDevice); + + /* Error out if the device is not an Android device or an error occurred */ + if ((ErrorCode != AccessoryModeAndroidDevice) && (ErrorCode != NonAccessoryModeAndroidDevice)) + { + if (ErrorCode == ControlError) + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Get Device).\r\n")); + else + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Invalid Device.\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + printf_P(PSTR("Android Device Detected - %sAccessory mode.\r\n"), (RequiresModeSwitch ? "Non-" : "")); + + /* Check if a valid Android device was attached, but it is not current in Accessory mode */ + if (RequiresModeSwitch) + { + uint16_t AndroidProtocol; + + /* Fetch the version of the Android Accessory Protocol supported by the device */ + if ((ErrorCode = Android_GetAccessoryProtocol(&AndroidProtocol)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Get Protocol).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* Validate the returned protocol version */ + if (AndroidProtocol != AOA_PROTOCOL_AccessoryV1) + { + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Accessory Mode Not Supported.")); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* Send the device strings and start the Android Accessory Mode */ + Android_SendString(AOA_STRING_Manufacturer, "Dean Camera"); + Android_SendString(AOA_STRING_Model, "LUFA Android Demo"); + Android_SendString(AOA_STRING_Description, "LUFA Android Demo"); + Android_SendString(AOA_STRING_Version, "1.0"); + Android_SendString(AOA_STRING_URI, "http://www.lufa-lib.org"); + Android_SendString(AOA_STRING_Serial, "0000000012345678"); + + Android_StartAccessoryMode(); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Getting Config Data.\r\n")); + + /* Get and process the configuration descriptor data */ + if ((ErrorCode = ProcessConfigurationDescriptor()) != SuccessfulConfigRead) + { + if (ErrorCode == ControlError) + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Get Configuration).\r\n")); + else + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Invalid Device.\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* Set the device configuration to the first configuration (rarely do devices use multiple configurations) */ + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Set Configuration).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Accessory Mode Android Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidAccessoryHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidAccessoryHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..36b2bf91e1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidAccessoryHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,86 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for AndroidAccessoryHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _ANDROID_ACCESSORY_HOST_H_ +#define _ANDROID_ACCESSORY_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include "DeviceDescriptor.h" + #include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + #include "Lib/AndroidAccessoryCommands.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void AndroidHost_Task(void); + + /* Event Handlers: */ + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidAccessoryHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidAccessoryHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..70e0935c9f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/AndroidAccessoryHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Android Accessory Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Android Accessory Host Class</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>Android Accessory Host Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Android Accessory Host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing an Android Accessory Host device capable of hosting + * Android powered mobile devices to send and receive data. + * + * Sent data from the Android device will be indicated onto the board's LEDs. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1d840f618c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} + #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS 0 +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/ConfigDescriptor.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/ConfigDescriptor.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d4aa877620 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/ConfigDescriptor.c @@ -0,0 +1,164 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Configuration Descriptor processing routines, to determine the correct pipe configurations + * needed to communication with an attached USB device. Descriptors are special computer-readable structures + * which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + +/** Reads and processes an attached device's descriptors, to determine compatibility and pipe configurations. This + * routine will read in the entire configuration descriptor, and configure the hosts pipes to correctly communicate + * with compatible devices. + * + * This routine searches for the first interface containing bulk IN and OUT data endpoints. + * + * \return An error code from the \ref AndroidHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t enum. + */ +uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void) +{ + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + void* CurrConfigLocation = ConfigDescriptorData; + uint16_t CurrConfigBytesRem; + + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Retrieve the entire configuration descriptor into the allocated buffer */ + switch (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &CurrConfigBytesRem, ConfigDescriptorData, sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData))) + { + case HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful: + break; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_InvalidData: + return InvalidConfigDataReturned; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_BuffOverflow: + return DescriptorTooLarge; + default: + return DevControlError; + } + + /* There should be only one compatible Android Accessory Mode interface in the device, attempt to find it */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DCOMP_NextAndroidAccessoryInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + while (!(DataINEndpoint) || !(DataOUTEndpoint)) + { + /* Get the next Android Accessory Mode interface's data endpoint descriptor */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DCOMP_NextInterfaceBulkEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Data endpoints not found within the first Android Accessory device interface, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Retrieve the endpoint address from the endpoint descriptor */ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* If the endpoint is a IN type endpoint */ + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + else + DataOUTEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + + /* Configure the Android Accessory data IN pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(ANDROID_DATA_IN_PIPE, EP_TYPE_BULK, DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + + /* Configure the Android Accessory data OUT pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(ANDROID_DATA_OUT_PIPE, EP_TYPE_BULK, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + + /* Valid data found, return success */ + return SuccessfulConfigRead; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interface descriptor containing the correct Android Accessory Mode Class, Subclass + * and Protocol values. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DCOMP_NextAndroidAccessoryInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + if ((Interface->Class == AOA_CSCP_AOADataClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == AOA_CSCP_AOADataSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == AOA_CSCP_AOADataProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next bulk Endpoint descriptor inside the current interface descriptor, aborting the + * search if another interface descriptor is found before the required endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DCOMP_NextInterfaceBulkEndpoint(void* const CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* Endpoint = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + uint8_t EndpointType = (Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK); + + if ((EndpointType == EP_TYPE_BULK) && (!(Pipe_IsEndpointBound(Endpoint->EndpointAddress)))) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/ConfigDescriptor.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/ConfigDescriptor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f422f8c2e2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/ConfigDescriptor.h @@ -0,0 +1,67 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ConfigDescriptor.c. + */ + +#ifndef _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ +#define _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Pipe address of the Android Accessory data IN pipe. */ + #define ANDROID_DATA_IN_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Pipe address of the Android Accessory data OUT pipe. */ + #define ANDROID_DATA_OUT_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref ProcessConfigurationDescriptor() function. */ + enum AndroidHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t + { + SuccessfulConfigRead = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully */ + DevControlError = 1, /**< A control request to the device failed to complete successfully */ + DescriptorTooLarge = 2, /**< The device's Configuration Descriptor is too large to process */ + InvalidConfigDataReturned = 3, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor */ + NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 4, /**< A compatible interface with the required endpoints was not found */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void); + + uint8_t DCOMP_NextAndroidAccessoryInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DCOMP_NextInterfaceBulkEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/DeviceDescriptor.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/DeviceDescriptor.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..03841a9903 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/DeviceDescriptor.c @@ -0,0 +1,67 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptor processing routines, to determine the overall device parameters. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine information about + * the attached device. + */ + +#include "DeviceDescriptor.h" + +/** Reads and processes an attached device's Device Descriptor, to determine compatibility + * + * This routine checks to ensure that the attached device's VID and PID matches Google's for Android devices. + * + * \return An error code from the \ref AndroidHost_GetDeviceDescriptorDataCodes_t enum. + */ +uint8_t ProcessDeviceDescriptor(void) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor; + + /* Send the request to retrieve the device descriptor */ + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceDescriptor(&DeviceDescriptor) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return DevControlError; + + /* Validate returned data - ensure the returned data is a device descriptor */ + if (DeviceDescriptor.Header.Type != DTYPE_Device) + return InvalidDeviceDataReturned; + + /* Check the product ID to determine if the Android device is in accessory mode */ + if ((DeviceDescriptor.ProductID != ANDROID_ACCESSORY_PRODUCT_ID) && + (DeviceDescriptor.ProductID != ANDROID_ACCESSORY_ADB_PRODUCT_ID)) + { + return NonAccessoryModeAndroidDevice; + } + + return AccessoryModeAndroidDevice; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/DeviceDescriptor.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/DeviceDescriptor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3324b2a551 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/DeviceDescriptor.h @@ -0,0 +1,60 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for DeviceDescriptor.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DEVICEDESCRIPTOR_H_ +#define _DEVICEDESCRIPTOR_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "AndroidAccessoryHost.h" + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref ProcessDeviceDescriptor() function. */ + enum AndroidHost_GetDeviceDescriptorDataCodes_t + { + SuccessfulDeviceRead = 0, /**< Device Descriptor was processed successfully */ + ControlError = 1, /**< A control request to the device failed to complete successfully */ + InvalidDeviceDataReturned = 2, /**< The device returned an invalid Device Descriptor */ + IncorrectAndroidDevice = 3, /**< The attached device is not an Android device */ + NonAccessoryModeAndroidDevice = 4, /**< The attached device is an Android device in non-accessory mode */ + AccessoryModeAndroidDevice = 5, /**< The attached device is an Android device in accessory mode */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t ProcessDeviceDescriptor(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/Lib/AndroidAccessoryCommands.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/Lib/AndroidAccessoryCommands.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7446e073a3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/Lib/AndroidAccessoryCommands.c @@ -0,0 +1,84 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Android Accessory Mode utility functions, for the configuration of an attached + * Android device into Android Accessory Mode ready for general communication. + */ + +#include "AndroidAccessoryCommands.h" + +uint8_t Android_GetAccessoryProtocol(uint16_t* const Protocol) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_VENDOR | REQREC_DEVICE), + .bRequest = AOA_REQ_GetAccessoryProtocol, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = sizeof(uint16_t), + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(Protocol); +} + +uint8_t Android_SendString(const uint8_t StringIndex, + const char* const String) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_VENDOR | REQREC_DEVICE), + .bRequest = AOA_REQ_SendString, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = StringIndex, + .wLength = (strlen(String) + 1), + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest((char*)String); +} + +uint8_t Android_StartAccessoryMode(void) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_VENDOR | REQREC_DEVICE), + .bRequest = AOA_REQ_StartAccessoryMode, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(NULL); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/Lib/AndroidAccessoryCommands.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/Lib/AndroidAccessoryCommands.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..98fb0365df --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/Lib/AndroidAccessoryCommands.h @@ -0,0 +1,52 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for AndroidAccessoryCommands.c. + */ + +#ifndef _ANDROID_ACCESSORY_COMMANDS_H_ +#define _ANDROID_ACCESSORY_COMMANDS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <stdint.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t Android_GetAccessoryProtocol(uint16_t* const Protocol); + uint8_t Android_SendString(const uint8_t StringIndex, + const char* const String); + uint8_t Android_StartAccessoryMode(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..25b47661b5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,55 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Android Accessory Host Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.android.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.android"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.android" caption="Android Accessory Host Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Android Accessory Host demo, implementing a basic USB device whose LEDs can be controlled via an Android device. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="Android Accessory Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="AndroidAccessoryHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="AndroidAccessoryHost.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="DeviceDescriptor.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="ConfigDescriptor.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="AndroidAccessoryHost.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="DeviceDescriptor.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="ConfigDescriptor.h"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/AndroidAccessoryCommands.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/AndroidAccessoryCommands.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6fd6211d32 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Android Accessory Mode Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dff7ea60fa --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AndroidAccessoryHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = AndroidAccessoryHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c ConfigDescriptor.c DeviceDescriptor.c Lib/AndroidAccessoryCommands.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/AudioInputHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/AudioInputHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9db4798a56 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/AudioInputHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,250 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the AudioInputHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "AudioInputHost.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Audio Input Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Attached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Unattached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Getting Config Data.\r\n")); + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Get and process the configuration descriptor data */ + if ((ErrorCode = ProcessConfigurationDescriptor()) != SuccessfulConfigRead) + { + if (ErrorCode == ControlError) + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Get Configuration).\r\n")); + else + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Invalid Device.\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* Set the device configuration to the first configuration (rarely do devices use multiple configurations) */ + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Set Configuration).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SetInterfaceAltSetting(StreamingInterfaceIndex, + StreamingInterfaceAltSetting)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Could not set alternative streaming interface setting.\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_ENDPOINT), + .bRequest = AUDIO_REQ_SetCurrent, + .wValue = (AUDIO_EPCONTROL_SamplingFreq << 8), + .wIndex = StreamingEndpointAddress, + .wLength = sizeof(USB_Audio_SampleFreq_t), + }; + + USB_Audio_SampleFreq_t SampleRate = AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(48000); + + /* Select the control pipe for the request transfer */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + /* Set the sample rate on the streaming interface endpoint */ + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(&SampleRate)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Could not set requested Audio sample rate.\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + /* Sample reload timer initialization */ + TIMSK0 = (1 << OCIE0A); + OCR0A = ((F_CPU / 8 / 48000) - 1); + TCCR0A = (1 << WGM01); // CTC mode + TCCR0B = (1 << CS01); // Fcpu/8 speed + + /* Set speaker as output */ + DDRC |= (1 << 6); + + /* PWM speaker timer initialization */ + TCCR3A = ((1 << WGM30) | (1 << COM3A1) | (1 << COM3A0)); // Set on match, clear on TOP + TCCR3B = ((1 << WGM32) | (1 << CS30)); // Fast 8-Bit PWM, F_CPU speed + + puts_P(PSTR("Microphone Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** ISR to handle the reloading of the PWM timer with the next sample. */ +ISR(TIMER0_COMPA_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + uint8_t PrevPipe = Pipe_GetCurrentPipe(); + + Pipe_SelectPipe(AUDIO_DATA_IN_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Check if the current pipe can be read from (contains a packet) and the device is sending data */ + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + { + /* Retrieve the signed 16-bit audio sample, convert to 8-bit */ + int8_t Sample_8Bit = (Pipe_Read_16_LE() >> 8); + + /* Check to see if the bank is now empty */ + if (!(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + /* Acknowledge the packet, clear the bank ready for the next packet */ + Pipe_ClearIN(); + } + + /* Load the sample into the PWM timer channel */ + OCR3A = (Sample_8Bit ^ (1 << 7)); + + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS; + + /* Turn on LEDs as the sample amplitude increases */ + if (Sample_8Bit > 16) + LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4); + else if (Sample_8Bit > 8) + LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3); + else if (Sample_8Bit > 4) + LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2); + else if (Sample_8Bit > 2) + LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + Pipe_SelectPipe(PrevPipe); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/AudioInputHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/AudioInputHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cc83270f61 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/AudioInputHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,79 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for AudioInputHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _AUDIO_INPUT_HOST_H_ +#define _AUDIO_INPUT_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + #include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/AudioInputHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/AudioInputHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0736e0df47 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/AudioInputHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Audio Input Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Audio Class</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Standard Audio Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Audio 1.0 Class Specification \n + * USBIF Audio 1.0 Class Terminal Types Specification \n + * USBIF Audio 1.0 Data Formats Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Audio Input host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Audio host, for USB Audio devices using + * the USB Audio 1.0 class profile. + * + * Incoming audio will output in 8-bit PWM onto the timer 3 output compare + * channel A, and will also be indicated on the board LEDs. Decouple the PWM + * output with a capacitor and attach to a speaker to hear the audio. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/ConfigDescriptor.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/ConfigDescriptor.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..81ebf9d85f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/ConfigDescriptor.c @@ -0,0 +1,220 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Configuration Descriptor processing routines, to determine the correct pipe configurations + * needed to communication with an attached USB device. Descriptors are special computer-readable structures + * which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + +/** Index of the currently used Audio Streaming Interface within the device. */ +uint8_t StreamingInterfaceIndex = 0; + +/** Alternative Setting of the currently used Audio Streaming Interface within the device. */ +uint8_t StreamingInterfaceAltSetting = 0; + +/** Address of the streaming audio endpoint currently in use within the device. */ +uint8_t StreamingEndpointAddress = 0; + + +/** Reads and processes an attached device's descriptors, to determine compatibility and pipe configurations. This + * routine will read in the entire configuration descriptor, and configure the hosts pipes to correctly communicate + * with compatible devices. + * + * This routine searches for a Streaming Audio interface descriptor containing a valid Isochronous audio endpoint. + * + * \return An error code from the \ref AudioHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t enum. + */ +uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void) +{ + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + void* CurrConfigLocation = ConfigDescriptorData; + uint16_t CurrConfigBytesRem; + + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* AudioControlInterface = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* AudioStreamingInterface = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Retrieve the entire configuration descriptor into the allocated buffer */ + switch (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &CurrConfigBytesRem, ConfigDescriptorData, sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData))) + { + case HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful: + break; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_InvalidData: + return InvalidConfigDataReturned; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_BuffOverflow: + return DescriptorTooLarge; + default: + return ControlError; + } + + while (!(DataINEndpoint)) + { + /* See if we've found a likely compatible interface, and if there is an endpoint within that interface */ + if (!(AudioControlInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextAudioInterfaceDataEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Check if we haven't found an Audio Control interface yet, or if we have run out of related Audio Streaming interfaces */ + if (!(AudioControlInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextAudioStreamInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Find a new Audio Control interface if the current one doesn't contain a compatible streaming interface */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextAudioControlInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Save the interface in case we need to refer back to it later */ + AudioControlInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Find the next Audio Streaming interface within that Audio Control interface */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextAudioStreamInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + } + + /* Save the interface in case we need to refer back to it later */ + AudioStreamingInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Skip the remainder of the loop as we have not found an endpoint yet */ + continue; + } + + /* Retrieve the endpoint address from the endpoint descriptor */ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* Save the endpoint if it is an IN type endpoint */ + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + + StreamingInterfaceIndex = AudioStreamingInterface->InterfaceNumber; + StreamingInterfaceAltSetting = AudioStreamingInterface->AlternateSetting; + StreamingEndpointAddress = DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + + /* Configure the Audio data IN pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(AUDIO_DATA_IN_PIPE, EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS, DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize, 2); + + /* Valid data found, return success */ + return SuccessfulConfigRead; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interface descriptor of the correct Audio Control Class, Subclass and Protocol values. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextAudioControlInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + if ((Interface->Class == AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == AUDIO_CSCP_ControlSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == AUDIO_CSCP_ControlProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interface descriptor of the correct Audio Streaming Class, Subclass and Protocol values. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextAudioStreamInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + if ((Interface->Class == AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == AUDIO_CSCP_AudioStreamingSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == AUDIO_CSCP_StreamingProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Isochronous Endpoint descriptor within the current interface, aborting the + * search if another interface descriptor is found before the next endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextAudioInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* Endpoint = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + if ((Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK) == EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/ConfigDescriptor.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/ConfigDescriptor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..036319d723 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/ConfigDescriptor.h @@ -0,0 +1,72 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ConfigDescriptor.c. + */ + +#ifndef _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ +#define _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "AudioInputHost.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Pipe address for the Audio data IN pipe. */ + #define AUDIO_DATA_IN_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref ProcessConfigurationDescriptor() function. */ + enum AudioHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t + { + SuccessfulConfigRead = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully */ + ControlError = 1, /**< A control request to the device failed to complete successfully */ + DescriptorTooLarge = 2, /**< The device's Configuration Descriptor is too large to process */ + InvalidConfigDataReturned = 3, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor */ + NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 4, /**< A compatible interface with the required endpoints was not found */ + }; + + /* External Variables: */ + extern uint8_t StreamingInterfaceIndex; + extern uint8_t StreamingInterfaceAltSetting; + extern uint8_t StreamingEndpointAddress; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void); + + uint8_t DComp_NextAudioControlInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextAudioStreamInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextAudioInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f6defd91d7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Audio Input Host Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.audio_input.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.audio_input"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.audio_input" caption="Audio Input Host Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Audio Input Host demo, implementing a basic USB audio sink that can output incoming audio data to a speaker. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="Audio Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="AudioInputHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="AudioInputHost.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="ConfigDescriptor.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="AudioInputHost.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="ConfigDescriptor.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dda0086588 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Audio Input Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0f6098e2a8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioInputHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = AudioInputHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c ConfigDescriptor.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/AudioOutputHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/AudioOutputHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2e56d7f356 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/AudioOutputHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,250 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the AudioOutputHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "AudioOutputHost.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Audio Output Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + Buttons_Init(); + ADC_Init(ADC_FREE_RUNNING | ADC_PRESCALE_32); + ADC_SetupChannel(MIC_IN_ADC_CHANNEL); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); + + /* Start the ADC conversion in free running mode */ + ADC_StartReading(ADC_REFERENCE_AVCC | ADC_RIGHT_ADJUSTED | ADC_GET_CHANNEL_MASK(MIC_IN_ADC_CHANNEL)); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Attached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Unattached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Getting Config Data.\r\n")); + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Get and process the configuration descriptor data */ + if ((ErrorCode = ProcessConfigurationDescriptor()) != SuccessfulConfigRead) + { + if (ErrorCode == ControlError) + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Get Configuration).\r\n")); + else + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Invalid Device.\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* Set the device configuration to the first configuration (rarely do devices use multiple configurations) */ + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Set Configuration).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SetInterfaceAltSetting(StreamingInterfaceIndex, + StreamingInterfaceAltSetting)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Could not set alternative streaming interface setting.\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_ENDPOINT), + .bRequest = AUDIO_REQ_SetCurrent, + .wValue = (AUDIO_EPCONTROL_SamplingFreq << 8), + .wIndex = StreamingEndpointAddress, + .wLength = sizeof(USB_Audio_SampleFreq_t), + }; + + USB_Audio_SampleFreq_t SampleRate = AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(48000); + + /* Select the control pipe for the request transfer */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + /* Set the sample rate on the streaming interface endpoint */ + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(&SampleRate)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Could not set requested Audio sample rate.\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + /* Sample reload timer initialization */ + TIMSK0 = (1 << OCIE0A); + OCR0A = ((F_CPU / 8 / 48000) - 1); + TCCR0A = (1 << WGM01); // CTC mode + TCCR0B = (1 << CS01); // Fcpu/8 speed + + puts_P(PSTR("Speaker Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** ISR to handle the reloading of the endpoint with the next sample. */ +ISR(TIMER0_COMPA_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + uint8_t PrevPipe = Pipe_GetCurrentPipe(); + + Pipe_SelectPipe(AUDIO_DATA_OUT_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Check if the current pipe can be written to (device ready for more data) */ + if (Pipe_IsOUTReady()) + { + int16_t AudioSample; + + #if defined(USE_TEST_TONE) + static uint8_t SquareWaveSampleCount; + static int16_t CurrentWaveValue; + + /* In test tone mode, generate a square wave at 1/256 of the sample rate */ + if (SquareWaveSampleCount++ == 0xFF) + CurrentWaveValue ^= 0x8000; + + /* Only generate audio if the board button is being pressed */ + AudioSample = (Buttons_GetStatus() & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ? CurrentWaveValue : 0; + #else + /* Audio sample is ADC value scaled to fit the entire range */ + AudioSample = ((SAMPLE_MAX_RANGE / ADC_MAX_RANGE) * ADC_GetResult()); + + #if defined(MICROPHONE_BIASED_TO_HALF_RAIL) + /* Microphone is biased to half rail voltage, subtract the bias from the sample value */ + AudioSample -= (SAMPLE_MAX_RANGE / 2); + #endif + #endif + + Pipe_Write_16_LE(AudioSample); + Pipe_Write_16_LE(AudioSample); + + if (!(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + Pipe_SelectPipe(PrevPipe); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/AudioOutputHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/AudioOutputHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a37113b84a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/AudioOutputHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,88 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for AudioOutputHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _AUDIO_OUTPUT_HOST_H_ +#define _AUDIO_OUTPUT_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/ADC.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + #include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Maximum audio sample value for the microphone input. */ + #define SAMPLE_MAX_RANGE 0xFFFF + + /** Maximum ADC range for the microphone input. */ + #define ADC_MAX_RANGE 0x3FF + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/AudioOutputHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/AudioOutputHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5e79a33e38 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/AudioOutputHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,83 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Audio Output Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Audio Class</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Standard Audio Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Audio 1.0 Class Specification \n + * USBIF Audio 1.0 Class Terminal Types Specification \n + * USBIF Audio 1.0 Data Formats Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Audio Output host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Audio host, for USB Audio devices using + * the USB Audio 1.0 class profile. + * + * By default, the demo will produce a square wave test tone when the board + * button is pressed. If USE_TEST_TONE is not defined in the project makefile, + * incoming audio from the ADC channel 1 will be sampled and sent to the attached + * USB audio device instead. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MIC_IN_ADC_CHANNEL</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Sets the ADC channel used by the demo for the input audio samples from an attached microphone.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>USE_TEST_TONE</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, this alters the demo to produce a square wave test tone when the first board button is pressed + * instead of sampling the board microphone.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MICROPHONE_BIASED_TO_HALF_RAIL</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, this alters the demo so that the half VCC bias of the microphone input is subtracted.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ff8ed270de --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,51 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define MIC_IN_ADC_CHANNEL 2 + + #define MICROPHONE_BIASED_TO_HALF_RAIL + #define USE_TEST_TONE + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/ConfigDescriptor.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/ConfigDescriptor.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c9d442107b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/ConfigDescriptor.c @@ -0,0 +1,220 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Configuration Descriptor processing routines, to determine the correct pipe configurations + * needed to communication with an attached USB device. Descriptors are special computer-readable structures + * which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + +/** Index of the currently used Audio Streaming Interface within the device. */ +uint8_t StreamingInterfaceIndex = 0; + +/** Alternative Setting of the currently used Audio Streaming Interface within the device. */ +uint8_t StreamingInterfaceAltSetting = 0; + +/** Address of the streaming audio endpoint currently in use within the device. */ +uint8_t StreamingEndpointAddress = 0; + + +/** Reads and processes an attached device's descriptors, to determine compatibility and pipe configurations. This + * routine will read in the entire configuration descriptor, and configure the hosts pipes to correctly communicate + * with compatible devices. + * + * This routine searches for a Streaming Audio interface descriptor containing a valid Isochronous audio endpoint. + * + * \return An error code from the \ref AudioHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t enum. + */ +uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void) +{ + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + void* CurrConfigLocation = ConfigDescriptorData; + uint16_t CurrConfigBytesRem; + + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* AudioControlInterface = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* AudioStreamingInterface = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Retrieve the entire configuration descriptor into the allocated buffer */ + switch (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &CurrConfigBytesRem, ConfigDescriptorData, sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData))) + { + case HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful: + break; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_InvalidData: + return InvalidConfigDataReturned; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_BuffOverflow: + return DescriptorTooLarge; + default: + return ControlError; + } + + while (!(DataOUTEndpoint)) + { + /* See if we've found a likely compatible interface, and if there is an endpoint within that interface */ + if (!(AudioControlInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextAudioInterfaceDataEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Check if we haven't found an Audio Control interface yet, or if we have run out of related Audio Streaming interfaces */ + if (!(AudioControlInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextAudioStreamInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Find a new Audio Control interface if the current one doesn't contain a compatible streaming interface */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextAudioControlInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Save the interface in case we need to refer back to it later */ + AudioControlInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Find the next Audio Streaming interface within that Audio Control interface */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextAudioStreamInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + } + + /* Save the interface in case we need to refer back to it later */ + AudioStreamingInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Skip the remainder of the loop as we have not found an endpoint yet */ + continue; + } + + /* Retrieve the endpoint address from the endpoint descriptor */ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* Save the endpoint if it is an OUT type endpoint */ + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT) + DataOUTEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + + StreamingInterfaceIndex = AudioStreamingInterface->InterfaceNumber; + StreamingInterfaceAltSetting = AudioStreamingInterface->AlternateSetting; + StreamingEndpointAddress = DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + + /* Configure the Audio data OUT pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(AUDIO_DATA_OUT_PIPE, EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointSize, 2); + + /* Valid data found, return success */ + return SuccessfulConfigRead; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interface descriptor of the correct Audio Control Class, Subclass and Protocol values. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextAudioControlInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + if ((Interface->Class == AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == AUDIO_CSCP_ControlSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == AUDIO_CSCP_ControlProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interface descriptor of the correct Audio Streaming Class, Subclass and Protocol values. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextAudioStreamInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + if ((Interface->Class == AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == AUDIO_CSCP_AudioStreamingSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == AUDIO_CSCP_StreamingProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Isochronous Endpoint descriptor within the current interface, aborting the + * search if another interface descriptor is found before the next endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextAudioInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* Endpoint = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + if ((Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK) == EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/ConfigDescriptor.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/ConfigDescriptor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0ed865edcc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/ConfigDescriptor.h @@ -0,0 +1,73 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ConfigDescriptor.c. + */ + +#ifndef _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ +#define _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "AudioOutputHost.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Pipe address for the Audio data OUT pipe. */ + #define AUDIO_DATA_OUT_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 1) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref ProcessConfigurationDescriptor() function. */ + enum AudioHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t + { + SuccessfulConfigRead = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully */ + ControlError = 1, /**< A control request to the device failed to complete successfully */ + DescriptorTooLarge = 2, /**< The device's Configuration Descriptor is too large to process */ + InvalidConfigDataReturned = 3, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor */ + NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 4, /**< A compatible interface with the required endpoints was not found */ + }; + + /* External Variables: */ + extern uint8_t StreamingInterfaceIndex; + extern uint8_t StreamingInterfaceAltSetting; + extern uint8_t StreamingEndpointAddress; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void); + + uint8_t DComp_NextAudioControlInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextAudioStreamInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextAudioInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ebc1587c69 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,54 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Audio Output Host Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.audio_output.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.audio_output"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.audio_output" caption="Audio Output Host Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Audio Output Host demo, implementing a basic USB audio source that can output audio data to an attached device. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="Audio Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="AudioOutputHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="AudioOutputHost.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="ConfigDescriptor.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="AudioOutputHost.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="ConfigDescriptor.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.adc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c27221c69f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Audio Output Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b5acb9b294 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/AudioOutputHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = AudioOutputHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c ConfigDescriptor.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/ConfigDescriptor.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/ConfigDescriptor.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c98f0fbcec --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/ConfigDescriptor.c @@ -0,0 +1,183 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Configuration Descriptor processing routines, to determine the correct pipe configurations + * needed to communication with an attached USB device. Descriptors are special computer-readable structures + * which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + +/** Reads and processes an attached device's descriptors, to determine compatibility and pipe configurations. This + * routine will read in the entire configuration descriptor, and configure the hosts pipes to correctly communicate + * with compatible devices. + * + * This routine searches for a HID interface descriptor containing at least one Interrupt type IN endpoint. + * + * \return An error code from the \ref GenericHIDHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t enum. + */ +uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void) +{ + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + void* CurrConfigLocation = ConfigDescriptorData; + uint16_t CurrConfigBytesRem; + + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* HIDInterface = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Retrieve the entire configuration descriptor into the allocated buffer */ + switch (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &CurrConfigBytesRem, ConfigDescriptorData, sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData))) + { + case HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful: + break; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_InvalidData: + return InvalidConfigDataReturned; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_BuffOverflow: + return DescriptorTooLarge; + default: + return ControlError; + } + + while (!(DataINEndpoint) || !(DataOUTEndpoint)) + { + /* See if we've found a likely compatible interface, and if there is an endpoint within that interface */ + if (!(HIDInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextHIDInterfaceDataEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Not all HID devices have an OUT endpoint - if we've reached the end of the HID descriptor + * but only found the mandatory IN endpoint, it's safe to continue with the device enumeration */ + if (DataINEndpoint) + break; + + /* Get the next HID interface from the configuration descriptor */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextHIDInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Save the interface in case we need to refer back to it later */ + HIDInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Clear any found endpoints */ + DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Skip the remainder of the loop as we have not found an endpoint yet */ + continue; + } + + /* Retrieve the endpoint address from the endpoint descriptor */ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* If the endpoint is a IN type endpoint */ + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + else + DataOUTEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + + /* Configure the HID data IN pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(HID_DATA_IN_PIPE, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + Pipe_SetInterruptPeriod(DataINEndpoint->PollingIntervalMS); + + /* Check if the HID interface contained an optional OUT data endpoint */ + if (DataOUTEndpoint) + { + /* Configure the HID data OUT pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(HID_DATA_OUT_PIPE, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + } + + /* Valid data found, return success */ + return SuccessfulConfigRead; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interface descriptor of the correct HID Class value. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextHIDInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + /* Determine if the current descriptor is an interface descriptor */ + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Check the HID descriptor class, break out if correct class/protocol interface found */ + if (Interface->Class == HID_CSCP_HIDClass) + { + /* Indicate that the descriptor being searched for has been found */ + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + /* Current descriptor does not match what this comparator is looking for */ + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Endpoint descriptor inside the current interface descriptor, + * aborting the search if another interface descriptor is found before the required endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextHIDInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + /* Determine the type of the current descriptor */ + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + /* Indicate that the descriptor being searched for has been found */ + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + /* Indicate that the search has failed prematurely and should be aborted */ + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + + /* Current descriptor does not match what this comparator is looking for */ + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/ConfigDescriptor.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/ConfigDescriptor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8e7289124b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/ConfigDescriptor.h @@ -0,0 +1,69 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ConfigDescriptor.c. + */ + +#ifndef _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ +#define _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "GenericHIDHost.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Pipe address for the HID data IN pipe. */ + #define HID_DATA_IN_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Pipe address for the HID data OUT pipe. */ + #define HID_DATA_OUT_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref ProcessConfigurationDescriptor() function. */ + enum GenericHIDHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t + { + SuccessfulConfigRead = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully */ + ControlError = 1, /**< A control request to the device failed to complete successfully */ + DescriptorTooLarge = 2, /**< The device's Configuration Descriptor is too large to process */ + InvalidConfigDataReturned = 3, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor */ + NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 4, /**< A compatible interface with the required endpoints was not found */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void); + + uint8_t DComp_NextHIDInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextHIDInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/GenericHIDHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/GenericHIDHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..413ce375b7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/GenericHIDHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,269 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the GenericHIDHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "GenericHIDHost.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Generic HID Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + ReadNextReport(); + + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Attached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Unattached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Getting Config Data.\r\n")); + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Get and process the configuration descriptor data */ + if ((ErrorCode = ProcessConfigurationDescriptor()) != SuccessfulConfigRead) + { + if (ErrorCode == ControlError) + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Get Configuration).\r\n")); + else + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Invalid Device.\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* Set the device configuration to the first configuration (rarely do devices use multiple configurations) */ + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Set Configuration).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("HID Device Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Reads in and processes the next report from the attached device, displaying the report + * contents on the board LEDs and via the serial port. + */ +void ReadNextReport(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Select and unfreeze HID data IN pipe */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(HID_DATA_IN_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Check to see if a packet has been received */ + if (!(Pipe_IsINReceived())) + { + /* Refreeze HID data IN pipe */ + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return; + } + + /* Ensure pipe contains data before trying to read from it */ + if (Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed()) + { + uint8_t ReportINData[Pipe_BytesInPipe()]; + + /* Read in HID report data */ + Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(&ReportINData, sizeof(ReportINData), NULL); + + /* Print report data through the serial port */ + for (uint16_t CurrByte = 0; CurrByte < sizeof(ReportINData); CurrByte++) + printf_P(PSTR("0x%02X "), ReportINData[CurrByte]); + + puts_P(PSTR("\r\n")); + } + + /* Clear the IN endpoint, ready for next data packet */ + Pipe_ClearIN(); + + /* Refreeze HID data IN pipe */ + Pipe_Freeze(); +} + +/** Writes a report to the attached device. + * + * \param[in] ReportOUTData Buffer containing the report to send to the device + * \param[in] ReportIndex Index of the report in the device (zero if the device does not use multiple reports) + * \param[in] ReportType Type of report to send, either REPORT_TYPE_OUT or REPORT_TYPE_FEATURE + * \param[in] ReportLength Length of the report to send + */ +void WriteNextReport(uint8_t* ReportOUTData, + const uint8_t ReportIndex, + const uint8_t ReportType, + uint16_t ReportLength) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Select the HID data OUT pipe */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(HID_DATA_OUT_PIPE); + + /* Not all HID devices have an OUT endpoint (some require OUT reports to be sent over the + * control endpoint instead) - check to see if the OUT endpoint has been initialized */ + if (Pipe_IsConfigured() && (ReportType == REPORT_TYPE_OUT)) + { + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Ensure pipe is ready to be written to before continuing */ + if (!(Pipe_IsOUTReady())) + { + /* Refreeze the data OUT pipe */ + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return; + } + + /* If the report index is used, send it before the report data */ + if (ReportIndex) + Pipe_Write_8(ReportIndex); + + /* Write out HID report data */ + Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(ReportOUTData, ReportLength, NULL); + + /* Clear the OUT endpoint, send last data packet */ + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + /* Refreeze the data OUT pipe */ + Pipe_Freeze(); + } + else + { + /* Class specific request to send a HID report to the device */ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = HID_REQ_SetReport, + .wValue = ((ReportType << 8) | ReportIndex), + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = ReportLength, + }; + + /* Select the control pipe for the request transfer */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + /* Send the request to the device */ + USB_Host_SendControlRequest(ReportOUTData); + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/GenericHIDHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/GenericHIDHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..39ee9ed1c9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/GenericHIDHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for GenericHIDHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _GENERICHID_HOST_H_ +#define _GENERICHID_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + #include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** HID Report Type to indicate an IN report. */ + #define REPORT_TYPE_IN 1 + + /** HID Report Type to indicate an OUT report. */ + #define REPORT_TYPE_OUT 2 + + /** HID Report Type to indicate a FEATURE report. */ + #define REPORT_TYPE_FEATURE 3 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void ReadNextReport(void); + void WriteNextReport(uint8_t* ReportOUTData, + const uint8_t ReportIndex, + const uint8_t ReportType, + uint16_t ReportLength); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/GenericHIDHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/GenericHIDHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1c9b1875a9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/GenericHIDHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,64 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Generic HID Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Generic HID host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a Generic HID USB host, for any device implementing + * the HID profile. + * + * Received reports from the attached device are printed to the serial port. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2321a8139c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Generic HID Host Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.generic_hid.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.generic_hid"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.generic_hid" caption="Generic HID Host Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Generic HID Host demo, implementing a basic USB HID device that can send and receive data to and from an attached device. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="GenericHIDHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="GenericHIDHost.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="ConfigDescriptor.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="GenericHIDHost.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="ConfigDescriptor.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1a87042649 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Generic HID Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e42dad7720 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/GenericHIDHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = GenericHIDHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c ConfigDescriptor.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5bfc1a9bec --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.c @@ -0,0 +1,187 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Configuration Descriptor processing routines, to determine the correct pipe configurations + * needed to communication with an attached USB device. Descriptors are special computer-readable structures + * which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + +/** Reads and processes an attached device's descriptors, to determine compatibility and pipe configurations. This + * routine will read in the entire configuration descriptor, and configure the hosts pipes to correctly communicate + * with compatible devices. + * + * This routine searches for a HID interface descriptor containing at least one Interrupt type IN endpoint and HID descriptor. + * + * \return An error code from the \ref JoystickHostWithParser_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t enum. + */ +uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void) +{ + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + void* CurrConfigLocation = ConfigDescriptorData; + uint16_t CurrConfigBytesRem; + + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* HIDInterface = NULL; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t* HIDDescriptor = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Retrieve the entire configuration descriptor into the allocated buffer */ + switch (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &CurrConfigBytesRem, ConfigDescriptorData, sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData))) + { + case HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful: + break; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_InvalidData: + return InvalidConfigDataReturned; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_BuffOverflow: + return DescriptorTooLarge; + default: + return ControlError; + } + + while (!(DataINEndpoint)) + { + /* See if we've found a likely compatible interface, and if there is an endpoint within that interface */ + if (!(HIDInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextJoystickInterfaceDataEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Get the next HID interface from the configuration descriptor */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextJoystickInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Save the interface in case we need to refer back to it later */ + HIDInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Get the HID descriptor from the configuration descriptor */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextHID) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Save the HID descriptor for later use */ + HIDDescriptor = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + + /* Skip the remainder of the loop as we have not found an endpoint yet */ + continue; + } + + /* Retrieve the endpoint address from the endpoint descriptor */ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* If the endpoint is a IN type endpoint */ + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + + /* Configure the HID data IN pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(JOYSTICK_DATA_IN_PIPE, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + Pipe_SetInterruptPeriod(DataINEndpoint->PollingIntervalMS); + + /* Get the HID report size from the HID report descriptor */ + HIDReportSize = HIDDescriptor->HIDReportLength; + + /* Valid data found, return success */ + return SuccessfulConfigRead; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interface descriptor of the correct Joystick HID Class and Protocol values. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextJoystickInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Check the HID descriptor class, break out if correct class interface found */ + if ((Interface->Class == HID_CSCP_HIDClass)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Endpoint descriptor inside the current interface descriptor, aborting the + * search if another interface descriptor is found before the required endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextJoystickInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + else + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next HID descriptor within the current HID interface descriptor. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextHID(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == HID_DTYPE_HID) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + else + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fccf5ebc15 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.h @@ -0,0 +1,69 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ConfigDescriptor.c. + */ + +#ifndef _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ +#define _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "HIDReport.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Pipe address for the joystick report data pipe. */ + #define JOYSTICK_DATA_IN_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref ProcessConfigurationDescriptor() function. */ + enum JoystickHostWithParser_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t + { + SuccessfulConfigRead = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully */ + ControlError = 1, /**< A control request to the device failed to complete successfully */ + DescriptorTooLarge = 2, /**< The device's Configuration Descriptor is too large to process */ + InvalidConfigDataReturned = 3, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor */ + NoHIDInterfaceFound = 4, /**< A compatible HID interface was not found in the device's Configuration Descriptor */ + NoHIDDescriptorFound = 5, /**< A compatible HID descriptor was not found in the device's HID interface */ + NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 4, /**< A compatible interface with the required endpoints was not found */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void); + + uint8_t DComp_NextJoystickInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextJoystickInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextHID(void* CurrentDescriptor); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/HIDReport.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/HIDReport.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dadbb395de --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/HIDReport.c @@ -0,0 +1,111 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "HIDReport.h" + +/** Size in bytes of the attached device's HID report descriptor */ +uint16_t HIDReportSize; + +/** Processed HID report descriptor items structure, containing information on each HID report element */ +HID_ReportInfo_t HIDReportInfo; + + +/** Function to read in the HID report descriptor from the attached device, and process it into easy-to-read + * structures via the HID parser routines in the LUFA library. + * + * \return A value from the \ref JoystickHostWithParser_GetHIDReportDataCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t GetHIDReportData(void) +{ + /* Create a buffer big enough to hold the entire returned HID report */ + uint8_t HIDReportData[HIDReportSize]; + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = REQ_GetDescriptor, + .wValue = (HID_DTYPE_Report << 8), + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = HIDReportSize, + }; + + /* Select the control pipe for the request transfer */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + /* Send control request to retrieve the HID report from the attached device */ + if (USB_Host_SendControlRequest(HIDReportData) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ParseControlError; + + /* Send the HID report to the parser for processing */ + if (USB_ProcessHIDReport(HIDReportData, HIDReportSize, &HIDReportInfo) != HID_PARSE_Successful) + return ParseError; + + return ParseSuccessful; +} + +/** Callback for the HID Report Parser. This function is called each time the HID report parser is about to store + * an IN, OUT or FEATURE item into the HIDReportInfo structure. To save on RAM, we are able to filter out items + * we aren't interested in (preventing us from being able to extract them later on, but saving on the RAM they would + * have occupied). + * + * \param[in] CurrentItem Pointer to the item the HID report parser is currently working with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the item should be stored into the HID report structure, \c false if it should be discarded + */ +bool CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem(HID_ReportItem_t* const CurrentItem) +{ + bool IsJoystick = false; + + /* Iterate through the item's collection path, until either the root collection node or a collection with the + * Joystick Usage is found - this prevents Mice, which use identical descriptors except for the Mouse usage + * parent node, from being erroneously treated as a joystick + */ + for (HID_CollectionPath_t* CurrPath = CurrentItem->CollectionPath; CurrPath != NULL; CurrPath = CurrPath->Parent) + { + if ((CurrPath->Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_GENERIC_DCTRL) && + (CurrPath->Usage.Usage == USAGE_JOYSTICK)) + { + IsJoystick = true; + break; + } + } + + /* If a collection with the joystick usage was not found, indicate that we are not interested in this item */ + if (!IsJoystick) + return false; + + /* Check the attributes of the current joystick item - see if we are interested in it or not; + * only store BUTTON and GENERIC_DESKTOP_CONTROL items into the Processed HID Report + * structure to save RAM and ignore the rest + */ + return ((CurrentItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_BUTTON) || + (CurrentItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_GENERIC_DCTRL)); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/HIDReport.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/HIDReport.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..63e6b6ceb0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/HIDReport.h @@ -0,0 +1,79 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for HIDReport.c. + */ + +#ifndef _HID_REPORT_H_ +#define _HID_REPORT_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "JoystickHostWithParser.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage Page value for a toggle button. */ + #define USAGE_PAGE_BUTTON 0x09 + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage Page value for a Generic Desktop Control. */ + #define USAGE_PAGE_GENERIC_DCTRL 0x01 + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage for a Joystick. */ + #define USAGE_JOYSTICK 0x04 + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage value for a X axis movement. */ + #define USAGE_X 0x30 + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage value for a Y axis movement. */ + #define USAGE_Y 0x31 + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref GetHIDReportData() function. */ + enum JoystickHostWithParser_GetHIDReportDataCodes_t + { + ParseSuccessful = 0, /**< HID report descriptor parsed successfully */ + ParseError = 1, /**< Failed to fully process the HID report descriptor */ + ParseControlError = 2, /**< Control error occurred while trying to read the device HID descriptor */ + }; + + /* External Variables: */ + extern uint16_t HIDReportSize; + extern HID_ReportInfo_t HIDReportInfo; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t GetHIDReportData(void); + + bool CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem(HID_ReportItem_t* const CurrentItem); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/JoystickHostWithParser.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/JoystickHostWithParser.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a903c5767e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/JoystickHostWithParser.c @@ -0,0 +1,273 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the JoystickHostWithParser demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "JoystickHostWithParser.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Joystick HID Parser Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + JoystickHost_Task(); + + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Attached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Unattached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Getting Config Data.\r\n")); + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Get and process the configuration descriptor data */ + if ((ErrorCode = ProcessConfigurationDescriptor()) != SuccessfulConfigRead) + { + if (ErrorCode == ControlError) + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Get Configuration).\r\n")); + else + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Invalid Device.\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* Set the device configuration to the first configuration (rarely do devices use multiple configurations) */ + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Set Configuration).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + printf_P(PSTR("Processing HID Report (Size %d Bytes).\r\n"), HIDReportSize); + + /* Get and process the device's first HID report descriptor */ + if ((ErrorCode = GetHIDReportData()) != ParseSuccessful) + { + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Report Parse Error.\r\n")); + + if (!(HIDReportInfo.TotalReportItems)) + puts_P(PSTR("Not a valid Joystick." ESC_FG_WHITE)); + else + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Joystick Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Task to read and process the HID report descriptor and HID reports from the device + * and display the results onto the board LEDs. + */ +void JoystickHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Select and unfreeze joystick data pipe */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(JOYSTICK_DATA_IN_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Check to see if a packet has been received */ + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + { + /* Check if data has been received from the attached joystick */ + if (Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed()) + { + /* Create buffer big enough for the report */ + uint8_t JoystickReport[Pipe_BytesInPipe()]; + + /* Load in the joystick report */ + Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(JoystickReport, Pipe_BytesInPipe(), NULL); + + /* Process the read in joystick report from the device */ + ProcessJoystickReport(JoystickReport); + } + + /* Clear the IN endpoint, ready for next data packet */ + Pipe_ClearIN(); + } + + /* Freeze joystick data pipe */ + Pipe_Freeze(); +} + +/** Processes a read HID report from an attached joystick, extracting out elements via the HID parser results + * as required and displays movement and button presses on the board LEDs. + * + * \param[in] JoystickReport Pointer to a HID report from an attached joystick device + */ +void ProcessJoystickReport(uint8_t* JoystickReport) +{ + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS; + + /* Check each HID report item in turn, looking for joystick X/Y/button reports */ + for (uint8_t ReportNumber = 0; ReportNumber < HIDReportInfo.TotalReportItems; ReportNumber++) + { + /* Create a temporary item pointer to the next report item */ + HID_ReportItem_t* ReportItem = &HIDReportInfo.ReportItems[ReportNumber]; + + bool FoundData; + + if ((ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_BUTTON) && + (ReportItem->ItemType == HID_REPORT_ITEM_In)) + { + /* Get the joystick button value */ + FoundData = USB_GetHIDReportItemInfo(JoystickReport, ReportItem); + + /* For multi-report devices - if the requested data was not in the issued report, continue */ + if (!(FoundData)) + continue; + + /* If button is pressed, all LEDs are turned on */ + if (ReportItem->Value) + LEDMask = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + else if ((ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_GENERIC_DCTRL) && + ((ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Usage == USAGE_X) || + (ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Usage == USAGE_Y)) && + (ReportItem->ItemType == HID_REPORT_ITEM_In)) + { + /* Get the joystick relative position value */ + FoundData = USB_GetHIDReportItemInfo(JoystickReport, ReportItem); + + /* For multi-report devices - if the requested data was not in the issued report, continue */ + if (!(FoundData)) + continue; + + int16_t DeltaMovement = HID_ALIGN_DATA(ReportItem, int16_t); + + /* Check to see if a (non-zero) delta movement has been indicated */ + if (DeltaMovement) + { + /* Determine if the report is for the X or Y delta movement, light LEDs as appropriate */ + if (ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Usage == USAGE_X) + LEDMask |= ((DeltaMovement > 0) ? LEDS_LED1 : LEDS_LED2); + else + LEDMask |= ((DeltaMovement > 0) ? LEDS_LED3 : LEDS_LED4); + } + } + } + + /* Display the button information on the board LEDs */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/JoystickHostWithParser.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/JoystickHostWithParser.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..944664f972 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/JoystickHostWithParser.h @@ -0,0 +1,83 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for JoystickHostWithParser.c. + */ + +#ifndef _JOYSTICK_HOST_H_ +#define _JOYSTICK_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + #include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + #include "HIDReport.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void JoystickHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + + void ProcessJoystickReport(uint8_t* JoystickReport); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/JoystickHostWithParser.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/JoystickHostWithParser.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9eba4ed864 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/JoystickHostWithParser.txt @@ -0,0 +1,71 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Joystick Host With HID Descriptor Parser Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Joystick host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Joystick host, for USB joysticks using + * the standard joystick HID profile. It uses a HID parser for the HID + * reports, allowing for correct operation across all USB joysticks. This + * demo supports joysticks with a single HID report. + * + * Joystick movement and button presses are displayed on the board LEDs. + * On connection to a USB joystick, the report items will be processed and + * printed as a formatted list through the USART before the joystick is + * fully enumerated. + * + * Currently only single interface joysticks are supported. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f2b919511a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,52 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Joystick HID (with parser) Host Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.joystick_parser.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.joystick_parser"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.joystick_parser" caption="Joystick HID (with parser) Host Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Joystick HID Host demo with HID parser, implementing a basic USB joystick host that can display movement data on the board LEDs. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="JoystickHostWithParser.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="JoystickHostWithParser.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="ConfigDescriptor.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="HIDReport.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="JoystickHostWithParser.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="ConfigDescriptor.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="HIDReport.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e8f82b8fed --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Joystick Host Demo (Using HID Descriptor Parser)" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..45c20b790d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/JoystickHostWithParser/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = JoystickHostWithParser +SRC = $(TARGET).c ConfigDescriptor.c HIDReport.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/ConfigDescriptor.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/ConfigDescriptor.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1c152b7402 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/ConfigDescriptor.c @@ -0,0 +1,155 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Configuration Descriptor processing routines, to determine the correct pipe configurations + * needed to communication with an attached USB device. Descriptors are special computer-readable structures + * which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + +/** Reads and processes an attached device's descriptors, to determine compatibility and pipe configurations. This + * routine will read in the entire configuration descriptor, and configure the hosts pipes to correctly communicate + * with compatible devices. + * + * This routine searches for a HID interface descriptor containing at least one Interrupt type IN endpoint. + * + * \return An error code from the \ref KeyboardHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t enum. + */ +uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void) +{ + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + void* CurrConfigLocation = ConfigDescriptorData; + uint16_t CurrConfigBytesRem; + + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* HIDInterface = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Retrieve the entire configuration descriptor into the allocated buffer */ + switch (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &CurrConfigBytesRem, ConfigDescriptorData, sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData))) + { + case HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful: + break; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_InvalidData: + return InvalidConfigDataReturned; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_BuffOverflow: + return DescriptorTooLarge; + default: + return ControlError; + } + + while (!(DataINEndpoint)) + { + /* See if we've found a likely compatible interface, and if there is an endpoint within that interface */ + if (!(HIDInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextKeyboardInterfaceDataEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Get the next HID interface from the configuration descriptor */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextKeyboardInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Save the interface in case we need to refer back to it later */ + HIDInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Skip the remainder of the loop as we have not found an endpoint yet */ + continue; + } + + /* Retrieve the endpoint address from the endpoint descriptor */ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* If the endpoint is a IN type endpoint */ + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + + /* Configure the HID data IN pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(KEYBOARD_DATA_IN_PIPE, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + Pipe_SetInterruptPeriod(DataINEndpoint->PollingIntervalMS); + + /* Valid data found, return success */ + return SuccessfulConfigRead; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interface descriptor of the correct Keyboard HID Class and Protocol values. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextKeyboardInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Check the HID descriptor class and protocol, break out if correct class/protocol interface found */ + if ((Interface->Class == HID_CSCP_HIDClass) && + (Interface->Protocol == HID_CSCP_KeyboardBootProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Endpoint descriptor inside the current interface descriptor, aborting the + * search if another interface descriptor is found before the required endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextKeyboardInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + else + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/ConfigDescriptor.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/ConfigDescriptor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e6da558bfd --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/ConfigDescriptor.h @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ConfigDescriptor.c. + */ + +#ifndef _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ +#define _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "KeyboardHost.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Pipe address for the keyboard data IN pipe. */ + #define KEYBOARD_DATA_IN_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref ProcessConfigurationDescriptor() function. */ + enum KeyboardHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t + { + SuccessfulConfigRead = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully */ + ControlError = 1, /**< A control request to the device failed to complete successfully */ + DescriptorTooLarge = 2, /**< The device's Configuration Descriptor is too large to process */ + InvalidConfigDataReturned = 3, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor */ + NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 4, /**< A compatible interface with the required endpoints was not found */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void); + + uint8_t DComp_NextKeyboardInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextKeyboardInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..df73383392 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,264 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the KeyboardHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "KeyboardHost.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Keyboard HID Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + KeyboardHost_Task(); + + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Attached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Unattached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Getting Config Data.\r\n")); + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Get and process the configuration descriptor data */ + if ((ErrorCode = ProcessConfigurationDescriptor()) != SuccessfulConfigRead) + { + if (ErrorCode == ControlError) + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Get Configuration).\r\n")); + else + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Invalid Device.\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* Set the device configuration to the first configuration (rarely do devices use multiple configurations) */ + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Set Configuration).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* HID class request to set the keyboard protocol to the Boot Protocol */ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = HID_REQ_SetProtocol, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + /* Select the control pipe for the request transfer */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + /* Send the request, display error and wait for device detach if request fails */ + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(NULL)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Set Protocol).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Keyboard Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Task to read in and processes the next report from the attached device, displaying the report + * contents on the board LEDs and via the serial port. + */ +void KeyboardHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Select keyboard data pipe */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(KEYBOARD_DATA_IN_PIPE); + + /* Unfreeze keyboard data pipe */ + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Check to see if a packet has been received */ + if (!(Pipe_IsINReceived())) + { + /* Refreeze HID data IN pipe */ + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return; + } + + /* Ensure pipe contains data before trying to read from it */ + if (Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed()) + { + USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t KeyboardReport; + + /* Read in keyboard report data */ + Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(&KeyboardReport, sizeof(KeyboardReport), NULL); + + /* Indicate if the modifier byte is non-zero (special key such as shift is being pressed) */ + LEDs_ChangeLEDs(LEDS_LED1, (KeyboardReport.Modifier) ? LEDS_LED1 : 0); + + uint8_t KeyCode = KeyboardReport.KeyCode[0]; + + /* Check if a key has been pressed */ + if (KeyCode) + { + /* Toggle status LED to indicate keypress */ + LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_LED2); + + char PressedKey = 0; + + /* Retrieve pressed key character if alphanumeric */ + if ((KeyCode >= HID_KEYBOARD_SC_A) && (KeyCode <= HID_KEYBOARD_SC_Z)) + { + PressedKey = (KeyCode - HID_KEYBOARD_SC_A) + 'A'; + } + else if ((KeyCode >= HID_KEYBOARD_SC_1_AND_EXCLAMATION) & + (KeyCode < HID_KEYBOARD_SC_0_AND_CLOSING_PARENTHESIS)) + { + PressedKey = (KeyCode - HID_KEYBOARD_SC_1_AND_EXCLAMATION) + '1'; + } + else if (KeyCode == HID_KEYBOARD_SC_0_AND_CLOSING_PARENTHESIS) + { + PressedKey = '0'; + } + else if (KeyCode == HID_KEYBOARD_SC_SPACE) + { + PressedKey = ' '; + } + else if (KeyCode == HID_KEYBOARD_SC_ENTER) + { + PressedKey = '\n'; + } + + /* Print the pressed key character out through the serial port if valid */ + if (PressedKey) + putchar(PressedKey); + } + } + + /* Clear the IN endpoint, ready for next data packet */ + Pipe_ClearIN(); + + /* Refreeze keyboard data pipe */ + Pipe_Freeze(); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..317c06565c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,80 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for KeyboardHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _KEYBOARD_HOST_H_ +#define _KEYBOARD_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + #include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void KeyboardHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..206ccc0118 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,73 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Keyboard Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Keyboard host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB keyboard host, for USB keyboards using + * the standard keyboard HID profile. + * + * Pressed alpha-numeric, enter or space key is transmitted through the serial + * USART at serial settings 9600, 8, N, 1. + * + * This uses a naive method where the keyboard is set to Boot Protocol mode, so + * that the report structure is fixed and known. A better implementation + * uses the HID report parser for correct report data processing across + * all compatible mice with advanced characteristics, as shown in the + * KeyboardHostWithParser demo application. + * + * Currently only single interface keyboards are supported. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1256e35404 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Keyboard HID Host Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.keyboard.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.keyboard"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.keyboard" caption="Keyboard HID Host Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Keyboard HID Host demo, implementing a basic USB keyboard host that can display key press data on the board LEDs. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="KeyboardHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="KeyboardHost.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="ConfigDescriptor.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="KeyboardHost.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="ConfigDescriptor.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..968ab03f18 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Keyboard Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..02a3aeb0a7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = KeyboardHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c ConfigDescriptor.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ab67915661 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.c @@ -0,0 +1,189 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Configuration Descriptor processing routines, to determine the correct pipe configurations + * needed to communication with an attached USB device. Descriptors are special computer-readable structures + * which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + +/** Reads and processes an attached device's descriptors, to determine compatibility and pipe configurations. This + * routine will read in the entire configuration descriptor, and configure the hosts pipes to correctly communicate + * with compatible devices. + * + * This routine searches for a HID interface descriptor containing at least one Interrupt type IN endpoint and HID descriptor. + * + * \return An error code from the \ref KeyboardHostWithParser_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t enum. + */ +uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void) +{ + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + void* CurrConfigLocation = ConfigDescriptorData; + uint16_t CurrConfigBytesRem; + + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* HIDInterface = NULL; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t* HIDDescriptor = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Retrieve the entire configuration descriptor into the allocated buffer */ + switch (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &CurrConfigBytesRem, ConfigDescriptorData, sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData))) + { + case HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful: + break; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_InvalidData: + return InvalidConfigDataReturned; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_BuffOverflow: + return DescriptorTooLarge; + default: + return ControlError; + } + + while (!(DataINEndpoint)) + { + /* See if we've found a likely compatible interface, and if there is an endpoint within that interface */ + if (!(HIDInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextKeyboardInterfaceDataEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Get the next HID interface from the configuration descriptor */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextKeyboardInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Save the interface in case we need to refer back to it later */ + HIDInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Get the HID descriptor from the configuration descriptor */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextHID) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Save the HID descriptor for later use */ + HIDDescriptor = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + + /* Skip the remainder of the loop as we have not found an endpoint yet */ + continue; + } + + /* Retrieve the endpoint address from the endpoint descriptor */ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* If the endpoint is a IN type endpoint */ + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + + /* Configure the HID data IN pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(KEYBOARD_DATA_IN_PIPE, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + Pipe_SetInterruptPeriod(DataINEndpoint->PollingIntervalMS); + + /* Get the HID report size from the HID report descriptor */ + HIDReportSize = HIDDescriptor->HIDReportLength; + + /* Valid data found, return success */ + return SuccessfulConfigRead; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interface descriptor of the correct Keyboard HID Class and Protocol values. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextKeyboardInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Check the HID descriptor class, break out if correct class interface found */ + if (Interface->Class == HID_CSCP_HIDClass) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Endpoint descriptor inside the current interface descriptor, aborting the + * search if another interface descriptor is found before the required endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextKeyboardInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + else + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next HID descriptor within the current HID interface descriptor. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextHID(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == HID_DTYPE_HID) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + else + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4cf111ba57 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.h @@ -0,0 +1,67 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ConfigDescriptor.c. + */ + +#ifndef _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ +#define _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "HIDReport.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Pipe address for the keyboard report data IN pipe. */ + #define KEYBOARD_DATA_IN_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref ProcessConfigurationDescriptor() function. */ + enum KeyboardHostWithParser_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t + { + SuccessfulConfigRead = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully */ + ControlError = 1, /**< A control request to the device failed to complete successfully */ + DescriptorTooLarge = 2, /**< The device's Configuration Descriptor is too large to process */ + InvalidConfigDataReturned = 3, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor */ + NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 4, /**< A compatible interface with the required endpoints was not found */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void); + + uint8_t DComp_NextKeyboardInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextKeyboardInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextHID(void* CurrentDescriptor); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/HIDReport.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/HIDReport.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..95ef8b476d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/HIDReport.c @@ -0,0 +1,90 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "HIDReport.h" + +/** Size in bytes of the attached device's HID report descriptor */ +uint16_t HIDReportSize; + +/** Processed HID report descriptor items structure, containing information on each HID report element */ +HID_ReportInfo_t HIDReportInfo; + + +/** Function to read in the HID report descriptor from the attached device, and process it into easy-to-read + * structures via the HID parser routines in the LUFA library. + * + * \return A value from the \ref KeyboardHostWithParser_GetHIDReportDataCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t GetHIDReportData(void) +{ + /* Create a buffer big enough to hold the entire returned HID report */ + uint8_t HIDReportData[HIDReportSize]; + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = REQ_GetDescriptor, + .wValue = (HID_DTYPE_Report << 8), + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = HIDReportSize, + }; + + /* Select the control pipe for the request transfer */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + /* Send control request to retrieve the HID report from the attached device */ + if (USB_Host_SendControlRequest(HIDReportData) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ParseControlError; + + /* Send the HID report to the parser for processing */ + if (USB_ProcessHIDReport(HIDReportData, HIDReportSize, &HIDReportInfo) != HID_PARSE_Successful) + return ParseError; + + return ParseSuccessful; +} + +/** Callback for the HID Report Parser. This function is called each time the HID report parser is about to store + * an IN, OUT or FEATURE item into the HIDReportInfo structure. To save on RAM, we are able to filter out items + * we aren't interested in (preventing us from being able to extract them later on, but saving on the RAM they would + * have occupied). + * + * \param[in] CurrentItem Pointer to the item the HID report parser is currently working with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the item should be stored into the HID report structure, \c false if it should be discarded + */ +bool CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem(HID_ReportItem_t* const CurrentItem) +{ + /* Check the attributes of the current item - see if we are interested in it or not; + * only store KEYBOARD usage page items into the Processed HID Report structure to + * save RAM and ignore the rest + */ + return (CurrentItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_KEYBOARD); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/HIDReport.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/HIDReport.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3ad3109c25 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/HIDReport.h @@ -0,0 +1,67 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for HIDReport.c. + */ + +#ifndef _HID_REPORT_H_ +#define _HID_REPORT_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "KeyboardHostWithParser.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage Page value for a desktop keyboard. */ + #define USAGE_PAGE_KEYBOARD 0x07 + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref GetHIDReportData() function. */ + enum KeyboardHostWithParser_GetHIDReportDataCodes_t + { + ParseSuccessful = 0, /**< HID report descriptor parsed successfully */ + ParseError = 1, /**< Failed to fully process the HID report descriptor */ + ParseControlError = 2, /**< Control error occurred while trying to read the device HID descriptor */ + }; + + /* External Variables: */ + extern uint16_t HIDReportSize; + extern HID_ReportInfo_t HIDReportInfo; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t GetHIDReportData(void); + + bool CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem(HID_ReportItem_t* const CurrentItem); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e645cee037 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.c @@ -0,0 +1,285 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the KeyboardHostWithParser demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "KeyboardHostWithParser.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Keyboard HID Parser Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + KeyboardHost_Task(); + + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Attached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Getting Config Data.\r\n")); + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Get and process the configuration descriptor data */ + if ((ErrorCode = ProcessConfigurationDescriptor()) != SuccessfulConfigRead) + { + if (ErrorCode == ControlError) + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Get Configuration).\r\n")); + else + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Invalid Device.\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* Set the device configuration to the first configuration (rarely do devices use multiple configurations) */ + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + + { + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Set Configuration).\r\n")); + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + printf_P(PSTR("Processing HID Report (Size %d Bytes).\r\n"), HIDReportSize); + + /* Get and process the device's first HID report descriptor */ + if ((ErrorCode = GetHIDReportData()) != ParseSuccessful) + { + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Report Parse Error.\r\n")); + + if (!(HIDReportInfo.TotalReportItems)) + puts_P(PSTR("Not a valid Keyboard." ESC_FG_WHITE)); + else + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Keyboard Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Task to read in and processes the next report from the attached device, displaying the report + * contents on the board LEDs and via the serial port. + */ +void KeyboardHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Select and unfreeze keyboard data pipe */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(KEYBOARD_DATA_IN_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Check to see if a packet has been received */ + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + { + /* Check if data has been received from the attached keyboard */ + if (Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed()) + { + /* Create buffer big enough for the report */ + uint8_t KeyboardReport[Pipe_BytesInPipe()]; + + /* Load in the keyboard report */ + Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(KeyboardReport, Pipe_BytesInPipe(), NULL); + + /* Process the read in keyboard report from the device */ + ProcessKeyboardReport(KeyboardReport); + } + + /* Clear the IN endpoint, ready for next data packet */ + Pipe_ClearIN(); + } + + /* Freeze keyboard data pipe */ + Pipe_Freeze(); +} + +/** Processes a read HID report from an attached keyboard, extracting out elements via the HID parser results + * as required and prints pressed characters to the serial port. Each time a key is typed, a board LED is toggled. + * + * \param[in] KeyboardReport Pointer to a HID report from an attached keyboard device + */ +void ProcessKeyboardReport(uint8_t* KeyboardReport) +{ + /* Check each HID report item in turn, looking for keyboard scan code reports */ + for (uint8_t ReportNumber = 0; ReportNumber < HIDReportInfo.TotalReportItems; ReportNumber++) + { + /* Create a temporary item pointer to the next report item */ + HID_ReportItem_t* ReportItem = &HIDReportInfo.ReportItems[ReportNumber]; + + /* Check if the current report item is a keyboard scan-code */ + if ((ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_KEYBOARD) && + (ReportItem->Attributes.BitSize == 8) && + (ReportItem->Attributes.Logical.Maximum > 1) && + (ReportItem->ItemType == HID_REPORT_ITEM_In)) + { + /* Retrieve the keyboard scan-code from the report data retrieved from the device */ + bool FoundData = USB_GetHIDReportItemInfo(KeyboardReport, ReportItem); + + /* For multi-report devices - if the requested data was not in the issued report, continue */ + if (!(FoundData)) + continue; + + /* Key code is an unsigned char in length, cast to the appropriate type */ + uint8_t KeyCode = (uint8_t)ReportItem->Value; + + /* If scan-code is non-zero, a key is being pressed */ + if (KeyCode) + { + /* Toggle status LED to indicate keypress */ + LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_LED2); + + char PressedKey = 0; + + /* Retrieve pressed key character if alphanumeric */ + if ((KeyCode >= HID_KEYBOARD_SC_A) && (KeyCode <= HID_KEYBOARD_SC_Z)) + { + PressedKey = (KeyCode - HID_KEYBOARD_SC_A) + 'A'; + } + else if ((KeyCode >= HID_KEYBOARD_SC_1_AND_EXCLAMATION) & + (KeyCode < HID_KEYBOARD_SC_0_AND_CLOSING_PARENTHESIS)) + { + PressedKey = (KeyCode - HID_KEYBOARD_SC_1_AND_EXCLAMATION) + '1'; + } + else if (KeyCode == HID_KEYBOARD_SC_0_AND_CLOSING_PARENTHESIS) + { + PressedKey = '0'; + } + else if (KeyCode == HID_KEYBOARD_SC_SPACE) + { + PressedKey = ' '; + } + else if (KeyCode == HID_KEYBOARD_SC_ENTER) + { + PressedKey = '\n'; + } + + /* Print the pressed key character out through the serial port if valid */ + if (PressedKey) + putchar(PressedKey); + } + + /* Once a scan-code is found, stop scanning through the report items */ + break; + } + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ce29a84918 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#ifndef _KEYBOARD_HOST_H_ +#define _KEYBOARD_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + #include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + #include "HIDReport.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void KeyboardHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + + void ProcessKeyboardReport(uint8_t* KeyboardReport); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4c87965ca4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.txt @@ -0,0 +1,71 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Keyboard Host With HID Descriptor Parser Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Keyboard host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Keyboard host, for USB keyboards using + * the standard Keyboard HID profile. It uses a HID parser for the HID reports, + * allowing for correct operation across all USB keyboards. This demo supports + * keyboards with a single HID report. + * + * Pressed alpha-numeric, enter or space key is transmitted through the serial + * USART at serial settings 9600, 8, N, 1. On connection to a USB keyboard, the + * report items will be processed and printed as a formatted list through the + * USART before the keyboard is fully enumerated. + * + * Currently only single interface keyboards are supported. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..beeaff9b72 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,52 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Keyboard HID (with parser) Host Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.keyboard_parser.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.keyboard_parser"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.keyboard_parser" caption="Keyboard HID (with parser) Host Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Keyboard HID Host demo with HID parser, implementing a basic USB keyboard host that can display key press data on the board LEDs. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="KeyboardHostWithParser.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="KeyboardHostWithParser.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="ConfigDescriptor.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="HIDReport.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="KeyboardHostWithParser.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="ConfigDescriptor.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="HIDReport.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..084a65242f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Keyboard Host Demo (Using HID Descriptor Parser)" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f5910ea5da --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/KeyboardHostWithParser/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = KeyboardHostWithParser +SRC = $(TARGET).c ConfigDescriptor.c HIDReport.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/ConfigDescriptor.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/ConfigDescriptor.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c02ec555c1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/ConfigDescriptor.c @@ -0,0 +1,173 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Configuration Descriptor processing routines, to determine the correct pipe configurations + * needed to communication with an attached USB device. Descriptors are special computer-readable structures + * which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + +/** Reads and processes an attached device's descriptors, to determine compatibility and pipe configurations. This + * routine will read in the entire configuration descriptor, and configure the hosts pipes to correctly communicate + * with compatible devices. + * + * This routine searches for a MIDI interface descriptor pair containing bulk data IN and OUT endpoints. + * + * \return An error code from the \ref MIDIHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t enum. + */ +uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void) +{ + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + void* CurrConfigLocation = ConfigDescriptorData; + uint16_t CurrConfigBytesRem; + + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* MIDIInterface = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Retrieve the entire configuration descriptor into the allocated buffer */ + switch (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &CurrConfigBytesRem, ConfigDescriptorData, sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData))) + { + case HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful: + break; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_InvalidData: + return InvalidConfigDataReturned; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_BuffOverflow: + return DescriptorTooLarge; + default: + return ControlError; + } + + while (!(DataINEndpoint) || !(DataOUTEndpoint)) + { + /* See if we've found a likely compatible interface, and if there is an endpoint within that interface */ + if (!(MIDIInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextMIDIStreamingDataEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Get the next Mass Storage interface from the configuration descriptor */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextMIDIStreamingInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Save the interface in case we need to refer back to it later */ + MIDIInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Clear any found endpoints */ + DataINEndpoint = NULL; + DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Skip the remainder of the loop as we have not found an endpoint yet */ + continue; + } + + /* Retrieve the endpoint address from the endpoint descriptor */ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* If the endpoint is a IN type endpoint */ + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + else + DataOUTEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + + /* Configure the MIDI data IN pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(MIDI_DATA_IN_PIPE, EP_TYPE_BULK, DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + + /* Configure the MIDI data OUT pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(MIDI_DATA_OUT_PIPE, EP_TYPE_BULK, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + + /* Valid data found, return success */ + return SuccessfulConfigRead; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interface descriptor of the correct MIDI Streaming Class, Subclass and Protocol values. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextMIDIStreamingInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Check the MIDI descriptor class, subclass and protocol, break out if correct data interface found */ + if ((Interface->Class == AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == AUDIO_CSCP_MIDIStreamingSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == AUDIO_CSCP_StreamingProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next bulk IN or OUT endpoint within the current interface, aborting the search if + * another interface descriptor is found before the required endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextMIDIStreamingDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* Endpoint = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* Check the endpoint type, break out if correct BULK type endpoint found */ + if ((Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK) == EP_TYPE_BULK) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/ConfigDescriptor.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/ConfigDescriptor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7cceba0597 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/ConfigDescriptor.h @@ -0,0 +1,69 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ConfigDescriptor.c. + */ + +#ifndef _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ +#define _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "MIDIHost.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Pipe address for the MIDI data IN pipe. */ + #define MIDI_DATA_IN_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Pipe address for the MIDI data OUT pipe. */ + #define MIDI_DATA_OUT_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref ProcessConfigurationDescriptor() function. */ + enum MIDIHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t + { + SuccessfulConfigRead = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully */ + ControlError = 1, /**< A control request to the device failed to complete successfully */ + DescriptorTooLarge = 2, /**< The device's Configuration Descriptor is too large to process */ + InvalidConfigDataReturned = 3, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor */ + NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 4, /**< A compatible interface with the required endpoints was not found */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void); + + uint8_t DComp_NextMIDIStreamingInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextMIDIStreamingDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/MIDIHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/MIDIHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..95043d724e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/MIDIHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,266 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the MIDIHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "MIDIHost.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "MIDI Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + MIDIHost_Task(); + + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + Buttons_Init(); + Joystick_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Attached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Getting Config Data.\r\n")); + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Get and process the configuration descriptor data */ + if ((ErrorCode = ProcessConfigurationDescriptor()) != SuccessfulConfigRead) + { + if (ErrorCode == ControlError) + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Get Configuration).\r\n")); + else + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Invalid Device.\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* Set the device configuration to the first configuration (rarely do devices use multiple configurations) */ + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Set Configuration).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("MIDI Device Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Task to read in note on/off messages from the attached MIDI device and print it to the serial port. + * When the board joystick or buttons are pressed, note on/off messages are sent to the attached device. + */ +void MIDIHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(MIDI_DATA_IN_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + { + MIDI_EventPacket_t MIDIEvent; + + Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(&MIDIEvent, sizeof(MIDIEvent), NULL); + + if (!(Pipe_BytesInPipe())) + Pipe_ClearIN(); + + bool NoteOnEvent = (MIDIEvent.Event == MIDI_EVENT(0, MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON)); + bool NoteOffEvent = (MIDIEvent.Event == MIDI_EVENT(0, MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF)); + + if (NoteOnEvent || NoteOffEvent) + { + printf_P(PSTR("MIDI Note %s - Channel %d, Pitch %d, Velocity %d\r\n"), NoteOnEvent ? "On" : "Off", + ((MIDIEvent.Data1 & 0x0F) + 1), + MIDIEvent.Data2, MIDIEvent.Data3); + } + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + Pipe_SelectPipe(MIDI_DATA_OUT_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (Pipe_IsOUTReady()) + { + uint8_t MIDICommand = 0; + uint8_t MIDIPitch; + + static uint8_t PrevJoystickStatus; + uint8_t JoystickStatus = Joystick_GetStatus(); + uint8_t JoystickChanges = (JoystickStatus ^ PrevJoystickStatus); + + /* Get board button status - if pressed use channel 10 (percussion), otherwise use channel 1 */ + uint8_t Channel = ((Buttons_GetStatus() & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ? MIDI_CHANNEL(10) : MIDI_CHANNEL(1)); + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_LEFT) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_LEFT)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3C; + } + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_UP) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_UP)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3D; + } + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_RIGHT) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_RIGHT)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3E; + } + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_DOWN) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_DOWN)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3F; + } + + if (JoystickChanges & JOY_PRESS) + { + MIDICommand = ((JoystickStatus & JOY_PRESS)? MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON : MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF); + MIDIPitch = 0x3B; + } + + /* Check if a MIDI command is to be sent */ + if (MIDICommand) + { + MIDI_EventPacket_t MIDIEvent = (MIDI_EventPacket_t) + { + .Event = MIDI_EVENT(0, MIDICommand), + + .Data1 = MIDICommand | Channel, + .Data2 = MIDIPitch, + .Data3 = MIDI_STANDARD_VELOCITY, + }; + + /* Write the MIDI event packet to the pipe */ + Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(&MIDIEvent, sizeof(MIDIEvent), NULL); + + /* Send the data in the pipe to the device */ + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + /* Save previous joystick value for next joystick change detection */ + PrevJoystickStatus = JoystickStatus; + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/MIDIHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/MIDIHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..eceea09778 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/MIDIHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for MIDIHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MIDI_HOST_H_ +#define _MIDI_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + #include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void MIDIHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/MIDIHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/MIDIHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..33a8319f06 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/MIDIHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,60 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage MIDI Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Audio Class Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>MIDI Subclass</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF USB MIDI Audio Class Standard</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * MIDI host demonstration application. This demo will enumerate an attached USB-MIDI device, and print incoming MIDI note + * on and off messages on any channel to the serial port. Pressing the board joystick will send note on and off messages to + * the attached MIDI device, with the board HWB controlling the note channel. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0a19a117df --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,52 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="MIDI Host Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.midi.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.midi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.midi" caption="MIDI Host Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ MIDI Host demo, capable of sending and receiving MIDI messages to and from an attached device. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="MIDI Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="MIDIHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="MIDIHost.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="ConfigDescriptor.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="MIDIHost.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="ConfigDescriptor.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7a6906a271 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - MIDI Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cf24a871da --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MIDIHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = MIDIHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c ConfigDescriptor.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e2b5166f25 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY + #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS 5000 +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/ConfigDescriptor.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/ConfigDescriptor.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b65912d51a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/ConfigDescriptor.c @@ -0,0 +1,173 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Configuration Descriptor processing routines, to determine the correct pipe configurations + * needed to communication with an attached USB device. Descriptors are special computer-readable structures + * which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + +/** Reads and processes an attached device's descriptors, to determine compatibility and pipe configurations. This + * routine will read in the entire configuration descriptor, and configure the hosts pipes to correctly communicate + * with compatible devices. + * + * This routine searches for a MSD interface descriptor containing bulk IN and OUT data endpoints. + * + * \return An error code from the \ref MassStorageHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t enum. + */ +uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void) +{ + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + void* CurrConfigLocation = ConfigDescriptorData; + uint16_t CurrConfigBytesRem; + + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* MSInterface = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Retrieve the entire configuration descriptor into the allocated buffer */ + switch (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &CurrConfigBytesRem, ConfigDescriptorData, sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData))) + { + case HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful: + break; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_InvalidData: + return InvalidConfigDataReturned; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_BuffOverflow: + return DescriptorTooLarge; + default: + return ControlError; + } + + while (!(DataINEndpoint) || !(DataOUTEndpoint)) + { + /* See if we've found a likely compatible interface, and if there is an endpoint within that interface */ + if (!(MSInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextMSInterfaceBulkDataEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Get the next Mass Storage interface from the configuration descriptor */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextMSInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Save the interface in case we need to refer back to it later */ + MSInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Clear any found endpoints */ + DataINEndpoint = NULL; + DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Skip the remainder of the loop as we have not found an endpoint yet */ + continue; + } + + /* Retrieve the endpoint address from the endpoint descriptor */ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* If the endpoint is a IN type endpoint */ + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + else + DataOUTEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + + /* Configure the Mass Storage data IN pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(MASS_STORE_DATA_IN_PIPE, EP_TYPE_BULK, DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + + /* Configure the Mass Storage data OUT pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(MASS_STORE_DATA_OUT_PIPE, EP_TYPE_BULK, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + + /* Valid data found, return success */ + return SuccessfulConfigRead; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interface descriptor of the correct Mass Storage Class, Subclass and Protocol values. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextMSInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Check the descriptor class and protocol, break out if correct class/protocol interface found */ + if ((Interface->Class == MASS_STORE_CLASS) && + (Interface->SubClass == MASS_STORE_SUBCLASS) && + (Interface->Protocol == MASS_STORE_PROTOCOL)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Bulk Endpoint descriptor of the correct MSD interface, aborting the search if + * another interface descriptor is found before the next endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextMSInterfaceBulkDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* Endpoint = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* Check the endpoint type, break out if correct BULK type endpoint found */ + if ((Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK) == EP_TYPE_BULK) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/ConfigDescriptor.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/ConfigDescriptor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..eaf4d28de6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/ConfigDescriptor.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ConfigDescriptor.c. + */ + +#ifndef _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ +#define _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "MassStorageHost.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Interface Class value for the Mass Storage Device class. */ + #define MASS_STORE_CLASS 0x08 + + /** Interface Class value for the Mass Storage Device subclass. */ + #define MASS_STORE_SUBCLASS 0x06 + + /** Interface Protocol value for the Bulk Only transport protocol. */ + #define MASS_STORE_PROTOCOL 0x50 + + /** Pipe address of the Mass Storage data IN pipe. */ + #define MASS_STORE_DATA_IN_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Pipe address of the Mass Storage data OUT pipe. */ + #define MASS_STORE_DATA_OUT_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref ProcessConfigurationDescriptor() function. */ + enum MassStorageHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t + { + SuccessfulConfigRead = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully */ + ControlError = 1, /**< A control request to the device failed to complete successfully */ + DescriptorTooLarge = 2, /**< The device's Configuration Descriptor is too large to process */ + InvalidConfigDataReturned = 3, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor */ + NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 4, /**< A compatible interface with the required endpoints was not found */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void); + + uint8_t DComp_NextMSInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextMSInterfaceBulkDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/Lib/MassStoreCommands.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/Lib/MassStoreCommands.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5f0dd6f1a4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/Lib/MassStoreCommands.c @@ -0,0 +1,635 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Mass Storage Device commands, to issue MSD commands to the device for + * reading device status, capacity, and other characteristics. This file + * also contains block read and write functions, so that device blocks + * can be read and written. In general, these functions would be chained + * to a FAT library to give file-level access to an attached device's contents. + * + * \note Many Mass Storage devices on the market are non-compliant to the + * specifications and thus can prove difficult to interface with. It + * may be necessary to retry the functions in the module several times + * after they have returned and error to successfully send the command + * to the device. Some devices may also need to have the stream function + * timeout period extended beyond 100ms (some badly designed devices exceeding + * 1.5 seconds occasionally) by defining USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS to a + * larger value in the project makefile and passing it to the compiler + * via the -D switch. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_MASSSTORE_COMMANDS_C +#include "MassStoreCommands.h" + +/** Current Tag value used in issued CBWs to the device. This is automatically incremented + * each time a command is sent, and is not externally accessible. + */ +static uint32_t MassStore_Tag = 1; + + +/** Routine to send the current CBW to the device, and increment the Tag value as needed. + * + * \param[in] SCSICommandBlock Pointer to a SCSI command block structure to send to the attached device + * \param[in,out] BufferPtr Pointer to a buffer for the data to send or receive to/from the device, or NULL if no data + * + * \return A value from the Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +static uint8_t MassStore_SendCommand(MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t* const SCSICommandBlock, + void* BufferPtr) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode = PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; + + /* Wrap Tag value when invalid - MS class defines tag values of 0 and 0xFFFFFFFF to be invalid */ + if (++MassStore_Tag == 0xFFFFFFFF) + MassStore_Tag = 1; + + /* Each transmission should have a unique tag value, increment before use */ + SCSICommandBlock->Tag = MassStore_Tag; + + /* Select the OUT data pipe for CBW transmission */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(MASS_STORE_DATA_OUT_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Write the CBW command to the OUT pipe */ + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(SCSICommandBlock, sizeof(MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t), NULL)) != + PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + { + Pipe_Freeze(); + return ErrorCode; + } + + /* Send the data in the OUT pipe to the attached device */ + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + /* Wait until command has been sent */ + Pipe_WaitUntilReady(); + + /* Freeze pipe after use */ + Pipe_Freeze(); + + if (BufferPtr != NULL) + { + /* Transfer the requested data (if any) to or from the device */ + ErrorCode = MassStore_SendReceiveData(SCSICommandBlock, (void*)BufferPtr); + + /* Only fail completely if the transfer fails without a STALL, as a logical STALL can be recovered from */ + if ((ErrorCode != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) && (ErrorCode != PIPE_RWSTREAM_PipeStalled)) + { + Pipe_Freeze(); + return ErrorCode; + } + } + + /* Retrieve the returned SCSI status from the device */ + MS_CommandStatusWrapper_t SCSIStatusBlock; + return MassStore_GetReturnedStatus(&SCSIStatusBlock); +} + +/** Waits until the attached device is ready to accept data following a CBW, checking + * to ensure that the device has not stalled the transaction. + * + * \return A value from the Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +static uint8_t MassStore_WaitForDataReceived(void) +{ + uint16_t TimeoutMSRem = COMMAND_DATA_TIMEOUT_MS; + uint16_t PreviousFrameNumber = USB_Host_GetFrameNumber(); + + /* Select the IN data pipe for data reception */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(MASS_STORE_DATA_IN_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Wait until data received in the IN pipe */ + while (!(Pipe_IsINReceived())) + { + uint16_t CurrentFrameNumber = USB_Host_GetFrameNumber(); + + /* Check to see if a new frame has been issued (1ms elapsed) */ + if (CurrentFrameNumber != PreviousFrameNumber) + { + /* Save the new frame number and decrement the timeout period */ + PreviousFrameNumber = CurrentFrameNumber; + TimeoutMSRem--; + + /* Check to see if the timeout period for the command has elapsed */ + if (!(TimeoutMSRem)) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_Timeout; + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + Pipe_SelectPipe(MASS_STORE_DATA_OUT_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Check if pipe stalled (command failed by device) */ + if (Pipe_IsStalled()) + { + /* Clear the stall condition on the OUT pipe */ + USB_Host_ClearEndpointStall(Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress()); + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_PipeStalled; + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + Pipe_SelectPipe(MASS_STORE_DATA_IN_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Check if pipe stalled (command failed by device) */ + if (Pipe_IsStalled()) + { + /* Clear the stall condition on the IN pipe */ + USB_Host_ClearEndpointStall(Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress()); + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_PipeStalled; + } + + /* Check to see if the device was disconnected, if so exit function */ + if (USB_HostState == HOST_STATE_Unattached) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(MASS_STORE_DATA_IN_PIPE); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + Pipe_SelectPipe(MASS_STORE_DATA_OUT_PIPE); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +/** Sends or receives the transaction's data stage to or from the attached device, reading or + * writing to the nominated buffer. + * + * \param[in] SCSICommandBlock Pointer to a SCSI command block structure being sent to the attached device + * \param[in,out] BufferPtr Pointer to the data buffer to read from or write to + * + * \return A value from the Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +static uint8_t MassStore_SendReceiveData(MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t* const SCSICommandBlock, + void* BufferPtr) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode = PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; + uint16_t BytesRem = SCSICommandBlock->DataTransferLength; + + /* Check the direction of the SCSI command data stage */ + if (SCSICommandBlock->Flags & MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_IN) + { + /* Wait until the device has replied with some data */ + if ((ErrorCode = MassStore_WaitForDataReceived()) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + /* Select the IN data pipe for data reception */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(MASS_STORE_DATA_IN_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Read in the block data from the pipe */ + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(BufferPtr, BytesRem, NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + /* Acknowledge the packet */ + Pipe_ClearIN(); + } + else + { + /* Select the OUT data pipe for data transmission */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(MASS_STORE_DATA_OUT_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Write the block data to the pipe */ + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(BufferPtr, BytesRem, NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + /* Acknowledge the packet */ + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + while (!(Pipe_IsOUTReady())) + { + if (USB_HostState == HOST_STATE_Unattached) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + } + } + + /* Freeze used pipe after use */ + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +/** Routine to receive the current CSW from the device. + * + * \param[out] SCSICommandStatus Pointer to a destination where the returned status data should be stored + * + * \return A value from the Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum, or MASS_STORE_SCSI_COMMAND_FAILED if the SCSI command fails + */ +static uint8_t MassStore_GetReturnedStatus(MS_CommandStatusWrapper_t* const SCSICommandStatus) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode = PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; + + /* If an error in the command occurred, abort */ + if ((ErrorCode = MassStore_WaitForDataReceived()) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + /* Select the IN data pipe for data reception */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(MASS_STORE_DATA_IN_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Load in the CSW from the attached device */ + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(SCSICommandStatus, sizeof(MS_CommandStatusWrapper_t), NULL)) != + PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + /* Clear the data ready for next reception */ + Pipe_ClearIN(); + + /* Freeze the IN pipe after use */ + Pipe_Freeze(); + + /* Check to see if command failed */ + if (SCSICommandStatus->Status != MS_SCSI_COMMAND_Pass) + ErrorCode = MASS_STORE_SCSI_COMMAND_FAILED; + + return ErrorCode; +} + +/** Issues a Mass Storage class specific request to reset the attached device's Mass Storage interface, + * readying the device for the next CBW. The Data endpoints are cleared of any STALL condition once this + * command completes successfully. + * + * \return A value from the USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum, or MASS_STORE_SCSI_COMMAND_FAILED if the SCSI command fails + */ +uint8_t MassStore_MassStorageReset(void) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = MS_REQ_MassStorageReset, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + /* Select the control pipe for the request transfer */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(NULL)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ErrorCode; + + /* Select first data pipe to clear STALL condition if one exists */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(MASS_STORE_DATA_IN_PIPE); + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_ClearEndpointStall(Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress())) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ErrorCode; + + /* Select second data pipe to clear STALL condition if one exists */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(MASS_STORE_DATA_OUT_PIPE); + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_ClearEndpointStall(Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress())) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ErrorCode; + + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; +} + +/** Issues a Mass Storage class specific request to determine the index of the highest numbered Logical + * Unit in the attached device. + * + * \note Some devices do not support this request, and will STALL it when issued. To get around this, + * on unsupported devices the max LUN index will be reported as zero and no error will be returned + * if the device STALLs the request. + * + * \param[out] MaxLUNIndex Pointer to the location that the maximum LUN index value should be stored + * + * \return A value from the USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum, or MASS_STORE_SCSI_COMMAND_FAILED if the SCSI command fails + */ +uint8_t MassStore_GetMaxLUN(uint8_t* const MaxLUNIndex) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = MS_REQ_GetMaxLUN, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = 1, + }; + + /* Select the control pipe for the request transfer */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(MaxLUNIndex)) == HOST_SENDCONTROL_SetupStalled) + { + /* Clear the pipe stall */ + Pipe_ClearStall(); + + /* Some faulty Mass Storage devices don't implement the GET_MAX_LUN request, so assume a single LUN */ + *MaxLUNIndex = 0; + + /* Clear the error, and pretend the request executed correctly if the device STALLed it */ + ErrorCode = HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; + } + + return ErrorCode; +} + +/** Issues a SCSI Inquiry command to the attached device, to determine the device's information. This + * gives information on the device's capabilities. + * + * \param[in] LUNIndex Index of the LUN inside the device the command is being addressed to + * \param[out] InquiryPtr Pointer to the inquiry data structure where the inquiry data from the device is to be stored + * + * \return A value from the Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum, or MASS_STORE_SCSI_COMMAND_FAILED if the SCSI command fails + */ +uint8_t MassStore_Inquiry(const uint8_t LUNIndex, + SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t* const InquiryPtr) +{ + /* Create a CBW with a SCSI command to issue INQUIRY command */ + MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t SCSICommandBlock = (MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t) + { + .Signature = MS_CBW_SIGNATURE, + .DataTransferLength = sizeof(SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t), + .Flags = MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_IN, + .LUN = LUNIndex, + .SCSICommandLength = 6, + .SCSICommandData = + { + SCSI_CMD_INQUIRY, + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Reserved + sizeof(SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t), // Allocation Length + 0x00 // Unused (control) + } + }; + + /* Send the command and any data to the attached device */ + return MassStore_SendCommand(&SCSICommandBlock, InquiryPtr); +} + +/** Issues a SCSI Request Sense command to the attached device, to determine the current SCSI sense information. This + * gives error codes for the last issued SCSI command to the device. + * + * \param[in] LUNIndex Index of the LUN inside the device the command is being addressed to + * \param[out] SensePtr Pointer to the sense data structure where the sense data from the device is to be stored + * + * \return A value from the Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum, or MASS_STORE_SCSI_COMMAND_FAILED if the SCSI command fails + */ +uint8_t MassStore_RequestSense(const uint8_t LUNIndex, + SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t* const SensePtr) +{ + /* Create a CBW with a SCSI command to issue REQUEST SENSE command */ + MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t SCSICommandBlock = (MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t) + { + .Signature = MS_CBW_SIGNATURE, + .DataTransferLength = sizeof(SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t), + .Flags = MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_IN, + .LUN = LUNIndex, + .SCSICommandLength = 6, + .SCSICommandData = + { + SCSI_CMD_REQUEST_SENSE, + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Reserved + sizeof(SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t), // Allocation Length + 0x00 // Unused (control) + } + }; + + /* Send the command and any data to the attached device */ + return MassStore_SendCommand(&SCSICommandBlock, SensePtr); +} + +/** Issues a SCSI Device Block Read command to the attached device, to read in one or more data blocks from the + * storage medium into a buffer. + * + * \param[in] LUNIndex Index of the LUN inside the device the command is being addressed to + * \param[in] BlockAddress Start block address to read from + * \param[in] Blocks Number of blocks to read from the device + * \param[in] BlockSize Size in bytes of each block to read + * \param[out] BufferPtr Pointer to the buffer where the read data is to be written to + * + * \return A value from the Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum, or MASS_STORE_SCSI_COMMAND_FAILED if the SCSI command fails + */ +uint8_t MassStore_ReadDeviceBlock(const uint8_t LUNIndex, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + const uint8_t Blocks, + const uint16_t BlockSize, + void* BufferPtr) +{ + /* Create a CBW with a SCSI command to read in the given blocks from the device */ + MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t SCSICommandBlock = (MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t) + { + .Signature = MS_CBW_SIGNATURE, + .DataTransferLength = ((uint32_t)Blocks * BlockSize), + .Flags = MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_IN, + .LUN = LUNIndex, + .SCSICommandLength = 10, + .SCSICommandData = + { + SCSI_CMD_READ_10, + 0x00, // Unused (control bits, all off) + (BlockAddress >> 24), // MSB of Block Address + (BlockAddress >> 16), + (BlockAddress >> 8), + (BlockAddress & 0xFF), // LSB of Block Address + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // MSB of Total Blocks to Read + Blocks, // LSB of Total Blocks to Read + 0x00 // Unused (control) + } + }; + + /* Send the command and any data to the attached device */ + return MassStore_SendCommand(&SCSICommandBlock, BufferPtr); +} + +/** Issues a SCSI Device Block Write command to the attached device, to write one or more data blocks to the + * storage medium from a buffer. + * + * \param[in] LUNIndex Index of the LUN inside the device the command is being addressed to + * \param[in] BlockAddress Start block address to write to + * \param[in] Blocks Number of blocks to write to in the device + * \param[in] BlockSize Size in bytes of each block to write + * \param[in] BufferPtr Pointer to the buffer where the write data is to be sourced from + * + * \return A value from the Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum, or MASS_STORE_SCSI_COMMAND_FAILED if the SCSI command fails + */ +uint8_t MassStore_WriteDeviceBlock(const uint8_t LUNIndex, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + const uint8_t Blocks, + const uint16_t BlockSize, + void* BufferPtr) +{ + /* Create a CBW with a SCSI command to write the given blocks to the device */ + MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t SCSICommandBlock = (MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t) + { + .Signature = MS_CBW_SIGNATURE, + .DataTransferLength = ((uint32_t)Blocks * BlockSize), + .Flags = MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_OUT, + .LUN = LUNIndex, + .SCSICommandLength = 10, + .SCSICommandData = + { + SCSI_CMD_WRITE_10, + 0x00, // Unused (control bits, all off) + (BlockAddress >> 24), // MSB of Block Address + (BlockAddress >> 16), + (BlockAddress >> 8), + (BlockAddress & 0xFF), // LSB of Block Address + 0x00, // Unused (reserved) + 0x00, // MSB of Total Blocks to Write + Blocks, // LSB of Total Blocks to Write + 0x00 // Unused (control) + } + }; + + /* Send the command and any data to the attached device */ + return MassStore_SendCommand(&SCSICommandBlock, BufferPtr); +} + +/** Issues a SCSI Device Test Unit Ready command to the attached device, to determine if the device is ready to accept + * other commands. + * + * \param[in] LUNIndex Index of the LUN inside the device the command is being addressed to + * + * \return A value from the Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum, or MASS_STORE_SCSI_COMMAND_FAILED if the SCSI command fails + */ +uint8_t MassStore_TestUnitReady(const uint8_t LUNIndex) +{ + /* Create a CBW with a SCSI command to issue TEST UNIT READY command */ + MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t SCSICommandBlock = (MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t) + { + .Signature = MS_CBW_SIGNATURE, + .DataTransferLength = 0, + .Flags = MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_IN, + .LUN = LUNIndex, + .SCSICommandLength = 6, + .SCSICommandData = + { + SCSI_CMD_TEST_UNIT_READY, + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00 // Unused (control) + } + }; + + /* Send the command and any data to the attached device */ + return MassStore_SendCommand(&SCSICommandBlock, NULL); +} + +/** Issues a SCSI Device Read Capacity command to the attached device, to determine the capacity of the + * given Logical Unit within the device. + * + * \param[in] LUNIndex Index of the LUN inside the device the command is being addressed to + * \param[out] CapacityPtr Device capacity structure where the capacity data is to be stored + * + * \return A value from the Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum, or MASS_STORE_SCSI_COMMAND_FAILED if the SCSI command fails + */ +uint8_t MassStore_ReadCapacity(const uint8_t LUNIndex, + SCSI_Capacity_t* const CapacityPtr) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode = PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; + + /* Create a CBW with a SCSI command to issue READ CAPACITY command */ + MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t SCSICommandBlock = (MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t) + { + .Signature = MS_CBW_SIGNATURE, + .DataTransferLength = sizeof(SCSI_Capacity_t), + .Flags = MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_IN, + .LUN = LUNIndex, + .SCSICommandLength = 10, + .SCSICommandData = + { + SCSI_CMD_READ_CAPACITY_10, + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // MSB of Logical block address + 0x00, + 0x00, + 0x00, // LSB of Logical block address + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Partial Medium Indicator + 0x00 // Unused (control) + } + }; + + /* Send the command and any data to the attached device */ + if ((ErrorCode = MassStore_SendCommand(&SCSICommandBlock, CapacityPtr)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + /* Endian-correct the read data */ + CapacityPtr->Blocks = SwapEndian_32(CapacityPtr->Blocks); + CapacityPtr->BlockSize = SwapEndian_32(CapacityPtr->BlockSize); + + return ErrorCode; +} + +/** Issues a SCSI Device Prevent/Allow Medium Removal command to the attached device, to lock the physical media from + * being removed. This is a legacy command for SCSI disks with removable storage (such as ZIP disks), but should still + * be issued before the first read or write command is sent. + * + * \param[in] LUNIndex Index of the LUN inside the device the command is being addressed to + * \param[in] PreventRemoval Whether or not the LUN media should be locked to prevent removal or not + * + * \return A value from the Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum, or MASS_STORE_SCSI_COMMAND_FAILED if the SCSI command fails + */ +uint8_t MassStore_PreventAllowMediumRemoval(const uint8_t LUNIndex, + const bool PreventRemoval) +{ + /* Create a CBW with a SCSI command to issue PREVENT ALLOW MEDIUM REMOVAL command */ + MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t SCSICommandBlock = (MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t) + { + .Signature = MS_CBW_SIGNATURE, + .DataTransferLength = 0, + .Flags = MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_OUT, + .LUN = LUNIndex, + .SCSICommandLength = 6, + .SCSICommandData = + { + SCSI_CMD_PREVENT_ALLOW_MEDIUM_REMOVAL, + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Reserved + PreventRemoval, // Prevent flag + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00 // Unused (control) + } + }; + + /* Send the command and any data to the attached device */ + return MassStore_SendCommand(&SCSICommandBlock, NULL); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/Lib/MassStoreCommands.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/Lib/MassStoreCommands.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4447687489 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/Lib/MassStoreCommands.h @@ -0,0 +1,86 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for MassStoreCommands.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MASS_STORE_COMMANDS_H_ +#define _MASS_STORE_COMMANDS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + + #include "../MassStorageHost.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Timeout period between the issuing of a CBW to a device, and the reception of the first packet. */ + #define COMMAND_DATA_TIMEOUT_MS 10000 + + /** Additional error code for Mass Storage functions when a device returns a logical command failure. */ + #define MASS_STORE_SCSI_COMMAND_FAILED 0xC0 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_MASSSTORE_COMMANDS_C) + static uint8_t MassStore_SendCommand(MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t* const SCSICommandBlock, + void* BufferPtr); + static uint8_t MassStore_WaitForDataReceived(void); + static uint8_t MassStore_SendReceiveData(MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t* const SCSICommandBlock, + void* BufferPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static uint8_t MassStore_GetReturnedStatus(MS_CommandStatusWrapper_t* const SCSICommandStatus) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + #endif + + uint8_t MassStore_MassStorageReset(void); + uint8_t MassStore_GetMaxLUN(uint8_t* const MaxLUNIndex); + uint8_t MassStore_RequestSense(const uint8_t LUNIndex, + SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t* const SensePtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + uint8_t MassStore_Inquiry(const uint8_t LUNIndex, + SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t* const InquiryPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + uint8_t MassStore_ReadDeviceBlock(const uint8_t LUNIndex, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + const uint8_t Blocks, + const uint16_t BlockSize, + void* BufferPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(5); + uint8_t MassStore_WriteDeviceBlock(const uint8_t LUNIndex, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + const uint8_t Blocks, + const uint16_t BlockSize, + void* BufferPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(5); + uint8_t MassStore_ReadCapacity(const uint8_t LUNIndex, + SCSI_Capacity_t* const CapacityPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + uint8_t MassStore_TestUnitReady(const uint8_t LUNIndex); + uint8_t MassStore_PreventAllowMediumRemoval(const uint8_t LUNIndex, + const bool PreventRemoval); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4d52470433 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,373 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the MassStorageHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "MassStorageHost.h" + +/** Index of the highest available LUN (Logical Unit) in the attached Mass Storage Device */ +uint8_t MassStore_MaxLUNIndex; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Mass Storage Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + MassStorageHost_Task(); + + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + Buttons_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Attached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Getting Config Data.\r\n")); + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Get and process the configuration descriptor data */ + if ((ErrorCode = ProcessConfigurationDescriptor()) != SuccessfulConfigRead) + { + if (ErrorCode == ControlError) + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Get Configuration).\r\n")); + else + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Invalid Device.\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* Set the device configuration to the first configuration (rarely do devices use multiple configurations) */ + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Set Configuration).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Mass Storage Disk Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Task to set the configuration of the attached device after it has been enumerated, and to read in blocks from + * the device and print them to the serial port. + */ +void MassStorageHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Indicate device busy via the status LEDs */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Send the request, display error and wait for device detach if request fails */ + if ((ErrorCode = MassStore_GetMaxLUN(&MassStore_MaxLUNIndex)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + ShowDiskReadError(PSTR("Get Max LUN"), ErrorCode); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + /* Print number of LUNs detected in the attached device */ + printf_P(PSTR("Total LUNs: %d - Using first LUN in device.\r\n"), (MassStore_MaxLUNIndex + 1)); + + /* Reset the Mass Storage device interface, ready for use */ + if ((ErrorCode = MassStore_MassStorageReset()) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + ShowDiskReadError(PSTR("Mass Storage Reset"), ErrorCode); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + /* Get sense data from the device - many devices will not accept any other commands until the sense data + * is read - both on start-up and after a failed command */ + SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t SenseData; + if ((ErrorCode = MassStore_RequestSense(0, &SenseData)) != 0) + { + ShowDiskReadError(PSTR("Request Sense"), ErrorCode); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + /* Set the prevent removal flag for the device, allowing it to be accessed */ + if ((ErrorCode = MassStore_PreventAllowMediumRemoval(0, true)) != 0) + { + ShowDiskReadError(PSTR("Prevent/Allow Medium Removal"), ErrorCode); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + /* Get inquiry data from the device */ + SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t InquiryData; + if ((ErrorCode = MassStore_Inquiry(0, &InquiryData)) != 0) + { + ShowDiskReadError(PSTR("Inquiry"), ErrorCode); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + /* Print vendor and product names of attached device */ + printf_P(PSTR("Vendor \"%.8s\", Product \"%.16s\"\r\n"), InquiryData.VendorID, InquiryData.ProductID); + + /* Wait until disk ready */ + puts_P(PSTR("Waiting until ready..")); + + for (;;) + { + Serial_SendByte('.'); + + /* Abort if device removed */ + if (USB_HostState == HOST_STATE_Unattached) + break; + + /* Check to see if the attached device is ready for new commands */ + ErrorCode = MassStore_TestUnitReady(0); + + /* If attached device is ready, abort the loop */ + if (!(ErrorCode)) + break; + + /* If an error other than a logical command failure (indicating device busy) returned, abort */ + if (ErrorCode != MASS_STORE_SCSI_COMMAND_FAILED) + { + ShowDiskReadError(PSTR("Test Unit Ready"), ErrorCode); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + } + + puts_P(PSTR("\r\nRetrieving Capacity... ")); + + /* Create new structure for the disk's capacity in blocks and block size */ + SCSI_Capacity_t DiskCapacity; + + /* Retrieve disk capacity */ + if ((ErrorCode = MassStore_ReadCapacity(0, &DiskCapacity)) != 0) + { + ShowDiskReadError(PSTR("Read Capacity"), ErrorCode); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + /* Display the disk capacity in blocks * block size bytes */ + printf_P(PSTR("%lu blocks of %lu bytes.\r\n"), DiskCapacity.Blocks, DiskCapacity.BlockSize); + + /* Create a new buffer capable of holding a single block from the device */ + uint8_t BlockBuffer[DiskCapacity.BlockSize]; + + /* Read in the first 512 byte block from the device */ + if ((ErrorCode = MassStore_ReadDeviceBlock(0, 0x00000000, 1, DiskCapacity.BlockSize, BlockBuffer)) != 0) + { + ShowDiskReadError(PSTR("Read Device Block"), ErrorCode); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("\r\nContents of first block:\r\n")); + + /* Print out the first block in both HEX and ASCII, 16 bytes per line */ + for (uint16_t Chunk = 0; Chunk < (DiskCapacity.BlockSize >> 4); Chunk++) + { + /* Pointer to the start of the current 16-byte chunk in the read block of data */ + uint8_t* ChunkPtr = &BlockBuffer[Chunk << 4]; + + /* Print out the 16 bytes of the chunk in HEX format */ + for (uint8_t ByteOffset = 0; ByteOffset < (1 << 4); ByteOffset++) + { + char CurrByte = *(ChunkPtr + ByteOffset); + + printf_P(PSTR("%.2X "), CurrByte); + } + + puts_P(PSTR(" ")); + + /* Print out the 16 bytes of the chunk in ASCII format */ + for (uint8_t ByteOffset = 0; ByteOffset < (1 << 4); ByteOffset++) + { + char CurrByte = *(ChunkPtr + ByteOffset); + + putchar(isprint(CurrByte) ? CurrByte : '.'); + } + + puts_P(PSTR("\r\n")); + } + + puts_P(PSTR("\r\n\r\nPress board button to read entire ASCII contents of disk...\r\n\r\n")); + + /* Wait for the board button to be pressed */ + while (!(Buttons_GetStatus() & BUTTONS_BUTTON1)) + { + /* Abort if device removed */ + if (USB_HostState == HOST_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + + /* Print out the entire disk contents in ASCII format */ + for (uint32_t CurrBlockAddress = 0; CurrBlockAddress < DiskCapacity.Blocks; CurrBlockAddress++) + { + /* Read in the next block of data from the device */ + if ((ErrorCode = MassStore_ReadDeviceBlock(0, CurrBlockAddress, 1, DiskCapacity.BlockSize, BlockBuffer)) != 0) + { + ShowDiskReadError(PSTR("Read Device Block"), ErrorCode); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + /* Send the ASCII data in the read in block to the serial port */ + for (uint16_t Byte = 0; Byte < DiskCapacity.BlockSize; Byte++) + { + char CurrByte = BlockBuffer[Byte]; + + putchar(isprint(CurrByte) ? CurrByte : '.'); + } + } + + /* Indicate device no longer busy */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); +} + +/** Indicates that a communication error has occurred with the attached Mass Storage Device, + * printing error codes to the serial port and waiting until the device is removed before + * continuing. + * + * \param[in] CommandString ASCII string located in PROGMEM space indicating what operation failed + * \param[in] ErrorCode Error code of the function which failed to complete successfully + */ +void ShowDiskReadError(const char* CommandString, + const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + if (ErrorCode == MASS_STORE_SCSI_COMMAND_FAILED) + { + /* Display the error code */ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "SCSI command error (%S).\r\n"), CommandString); + } + else + { + /* Display the error code */ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Command error (%S).\r\n"), CommandString); + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + /* Indicate device error via the status LEDs */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8459ecfe0e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,91 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for MassStoreHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MASS_STORE_HOST_H_ +#define _MASS_STORE_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + #include <ctype.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + + #include "Lib/MassStoreCommands.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void MassStorageHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + + void ShowDiskReadError(const char* CommandString, + const uint8_t ErrorCode); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4b07261c4f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,68 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Mass Storage Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Mass Storage Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Bulk Only</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Mass Storage Standard \n + * USB Bulk-Only Transport Standard \n + * SCSI Primary Commands Specification \n + * SCSI Block Commands Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Mass Storage host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Mass Storage host, for USB storage devices + * using the standard Mass Storage USB profile. + * + * The first 512 bytes (boot sector) of an attached disk's memory will be dumped + * out of the serial port in HEX and ASCII form when it is attached to the AT90USB1287 + * AVR. The device will then wait for HWB to be pressed, whereupon the entire ASCII contents + * of the disk will be dumped to the serial port. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8f04f692e8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,53 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Mass Storage Host Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.ms.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.ms"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.ms" caption="Mass Storage Host Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Mass Storage Host demo, capable of reading and writing raw 512 byte segments to the device's serial port. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="Mass Storage Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="MassStorageHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="MassStorageHost.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="ConfigDescriptor.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="MassStorageHost.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="ConfigDescriptor.h"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/MassStoreCommands.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/MassStoreCommands.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..58657165ca --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Mass Storage Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ad1bddec9a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MassStorageHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = MassStorageHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c ConfigDescriptor.c Lib/MassStoreCommands.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/ConfigDescriptor.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/ConfigDescriptor.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a7c16425ce --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/ConfigDescriptor.c @@ -0,0 +1,159 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Configuration Descriptor processing routines, to determine the correct pipe configurations + * needed to communication with an attached USB device. Descriptors are special computer-readable structures + * which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + +/** Reads and processes an attached device's descriptors, to determine compatibility and pipe configurations. This + * routine will read in the entire configuration descriptor, and configure the hosts pipes to correctly communicate + * with compatible devices. + * + * This routine searches for a HID interface descriptor containing at least one Interrupt type IN endpoint. + * + * \return An error code from the \ref MouseHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t enum. + */ +uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void) +{ + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + void* CurrConfigLocation = ConfigDescriptorData; + uint16_t CurrConfigBytesRem; + + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* HIDInterface = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Retrieve the entire configuration descriptor into the allocated buffer */ + switch (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &CurrConfigBytesRem, ConfigDescriptorData, sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData))) + { + case HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful: + break; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_InvalidData: + return InvalidConfigDataReturned; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_BuffOverflow: + return DescriptorTooLarge; + default: + return ControlError; + } + + while (!(DataINEndpoint)) + { + /* See if we've found a likely compatible interface, and if there is an endpoint within that interface */ + if (!(HIDInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextMouseInterfaceDataEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Get the next HID interface from the configuration descriptor */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextMouseInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Save the interface in case we need to refer back to it later */ + HIDInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Skip the remainder of the loop as we have not found an endpoint yet */ + continue; + } + + /* Retrieve the endpoint address from the endpoint descriptor */ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* If the endpoint is a IN type endpoint */ + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + + /* Configure the HID data IN pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(MOUSE_DATA_IN_PIPE, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + Pipe_SetInterruptPeriod(DataINEndpoint->PollingIntervalMS); + + /* Valid data found, return success */ + return SuccessfulConfigRead; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interface descriptor of the correct Mouse HID Class and Protocol values. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextMouseInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + /* Determine if the current descriptor is an interface descriptor */ + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Check the HID descriptor class and protocol, break out if correct class/protocol interface found */ + if ((Interface->Class == HID_CSCP_HIDClass) && + (Interface->Protocol == HID_CSCP_MouseBootProtocol)) + { + /* Indicate that the descriptor being searched for has been found */ + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + /* Current descriptor does not match what this comparator is looking for */ + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Endpoint descriptor inside the current interface descriptor, aborting the + * search if another interface descriptor is found before the required endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextMouseInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + /* Determine the type of the current descriptor */ + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + else + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/ConfigDescriptor.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/ConfigDescriptor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9a84559e4d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/ConfigDescriptor.h @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ConfigDescriptor.c. + */ + +#ifndef _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ +#define _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "MouseHost.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Pipe address for the mouse data IN pipe. */ + #define MOUSE_DATA_IN_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref ProcessConfigurationDescriptor() function. */ + enum MouseHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t + { + SuccessfulConfigRead = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully */ + ControlError = 1, /**< A control request to the device failed to complete successfully */ + DescriptorTooLarge = 2, /**< The device's Configuration Descriptor is too large to process */ + InvalidConfigDataReturned = 3, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor */ + NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 4, /**< A compatible interface with the required endpoints was not found */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void); + + uint8_t DComp_NextMouseInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextMouseInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/MouseHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/MouseHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d05cde41a1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/MouseHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,250 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the MouseHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "MouseHost.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Mouse HID Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + MouseHost_Task(); + + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Attached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Unattached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Getting Config Data.\r\n")); + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Get and process the configuration descriptor data */ + if ((ErrorCode = ProcessConfigurationDescriptor()) != SuccessfulConfigRead) + { + if (ErrorCode == ControlError) + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Get Configuration).\r\n")); + else + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Invalid Device.\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* Set the device configuration to the first configuration (rarely do devices use multiple configurations) */ + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Set Configuration).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* HID class request to set the mouse protocol to the Boot Protocol */ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = HID_REQ_SetProtocol, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + /* Select the control pipe for the request transfer */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + /* Send the request, display error and wait for device detach if request fails */ + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(NULL)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Set Protocol).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Mouse Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Reads in and processes the next report from the attached device, displaying the report + * contents on the board LEDs and via the serial port. + */ +void MouseHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + USB_MouseReport_Data_t MouseReport; + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS; + + /* Select mouse data pipe */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(MOUSE_DATA_IN_PIPE); + + /* Unfreeze mouse data pipe */ + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Check to see if a packet has been received */ + if (!(Pipe_IsINReceived())) + { + /* No packet received (no movement), turn off LEDs */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDS_NO_LEDS); + + /* Refreeze HID data IN pipe */ + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return; + } + + /* Ensure pipe contains data before trying to read from it */ + if (Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed()) + { + /* Read in mouse report data */ + Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(&MouseReport, sizeof(MouseReport), NULL); + + /* Alter status LEDs according to mouse X movement */ + if (MouseReport.X > 0) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED1; + else if (MouseReport.X < 0) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED2; + + /* Alter status LEDs according to mouse Y movement */ + if (MouseReport.Y > 0) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED3; + else if (MouseReport.Y < 0) + LEDMask |= LEDS_LED4; + + /* Alter status LEDs according to mouse button position */ + if (MouseReport.Button) + LEDMask = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); + + /* Print mouse report data through the serial port */ + printf_P(PSTR("dX:%2d dY:%2d Button:%d\r\n"), MouseReport.X, + MouseReport.Y, + MouseReport.Button); + } + + /* Clear the IN endpoint, ready for next data packet */ + Pipe_ClearIN(); + + /* Refreeze mouse data pipe */ + Pipe_Freeze(); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/MouseHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/MouseHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..58b863ab90 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/MouseHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for MouseHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MOUSE_HOST_H_ +#define _MOUSE_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + #include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void MouseHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + + void ReadNextReport(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/MouseHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/MouseHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..29364537b2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/MouseHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,74 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Mouse Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Mouse host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Mouse host, for USB mice using + * the standard mouse HID profile. + * + * Mouse movement and button presses are displayed on the board LEDs, + * as well as printed out the serial terminal as formatted dY, dY and + * button status information. + * + * This uses a naive method where the mouse is set to Boot Protocol mode, so + * that the report structure is fixed and known. A better implementation + * uses the HID report parser for correct report data processing across + * all compatible mice with advanced characteristics, as shown in the + * MouseHostWithParser demo application. + * + * Currently only single interface mice are supported. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4499986b39 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Mouse HID Host Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.mouse.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.mouse"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.mouse" caption="Mouse HID Host Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Keyboard HID Host demo, implementing a basic USB mouse host that can display movement data on the board LEDs. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="MouseHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="MouseHost.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="ConfigDescriptor.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="MouseHost.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="ConfigDescriptor.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a025dd58d9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Mouse Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4fb6c13c87 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = MouseHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c ConfigDescriptor.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c2c6301e09 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.c @@ -0,0 +1,187 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Configuration Descriptor processing routines, to determine the correct pipe configurations + * needed to communication with an attached USB device. Descriptors are special computer-readable structures + * which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + +/** Reads and processes an attached device's descriptors, to determine compatibility and pipe configurations. This + * routine will read in the entire configuration descriptor, and configure the hosts pipes to correctly communicate + * with compatible devices. + * + * This routine searches for a HID interface descriptor containing at least one Interrupt type IN endpoint and HID descriptor. + * + * \return An error code from the \ref MouseHostWithParser_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t enum. + */ +uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void) +{ + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + void* CurrConfigLocation = ConfigDescriptorData; + uint16_t CurrConfigBytesRem; + + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* HIDInterface = NULL; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t* HIDDescriptor = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Retrieve the entire configuration descriptor into the allocated buffer */ + switch (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &CurrConfigBytesRem, ConfigDescriptorData, sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData))) + { + case HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful: + break; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_InvalidData: + return InvalidConfigDataReturned; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_BuffOverflow: + return DescriptorTooLarge; + default: + return ControlError; + } + + while (!(DataINEndpoint)) + { + /* See if we've found a likely compatible interface, and if there is an endpoint within that interface */ + if (!(HIDInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextMouseInterfaceDataEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Get the next HID interface from the configuration descriptor */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextMouseInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Save the interface in case we need to refer back to it later */ + HIDInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Get the HID descriptor from the configuration descriptor */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextHID) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Save the HID descriptor for later use */ + HIDDescriptor = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + + /* Skip the remainder of the loop as we have not found an endpoint yet */ + continue; + } + + /* Retrieve the endpoint address from the endpoint descriptor */ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* If the endpoint is a IN type endpoint */ + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + + /* Configure the HID data IN pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(MOUSE_DATA_IN_PIPE, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + Pipe_SetInterruptPeriod(DataINEndpoint->PollingIntervalMS); + + /* Get the HID report size from the HID report descriptor */ + HIDReportSize = HIDDescriptor->HIDReportLength; + + /* Valid data found, return success */ + return SuccessfulConfigRead; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interface descriptor of the correct Mouse HID Class and Protocol values. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextMouseInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Check the HID descriptor class, break out if correct class interface found */ + if (Interface->Class == HID_CSCP_HIDClass) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Endpoint descriptor inside the current interface descriptor, aborting the + * search if another interface descriptor is found before the required endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextMouseInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + else + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next HID descriptor within the current HID interface descriptor. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextHID(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == HID_DTYPE_HID) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + else + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c43e176265 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.h @@ -0,0 +1,67 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ConfigDescriptor.c. + */ + +#ifndef _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ +#define _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "HIDReport.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Pipe address for the mouse report data IN pipe. */ + #define MOUSE_DATA_IN_PIPE (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref ProcessConfigurationDescriptor() function. */ + enum MouseHostWithParser_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t + { + SuccessfulConfigRead = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully */ + ControlError = 1, /**< A control request to the device failed to complete successfully */ + DescriptorTooLarge = 2, /**< The device's Configuration Descriptor is too large to process */ + InvalidConfigDataReturned = 3, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor */ + NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 4, /**< A compatible interface with the required endpoints was not found */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void); + + uint8_t DComp_NextMouseInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextMouseInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextHID(void* CurrentDescriptor); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/HIDReport.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/HIDReport.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3ec766fbdd --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/HIDReport.c @@ -0,0 +1,111 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "HIDReport.h" + +/** Size in bytes of the attached device's HID report descriptor */ +uint16_t HIDReportSize; + +/** Processed HID report descriptor items structure, containing information on each HID report element */ +HID_ReportInfo_t HIDReportInfo; + + +/** Function to read in the HID report descriptor from the attached device, and process it into easy-to-read + * structures via the HID parser routines in the LUFA library. + * + * \return A value from the \ref MouseHostWithParser_GetHIDReportDataCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t GetHIDReportData(void) +{ + /* Create a buffer big enough to hold the entire returned HID report */ + uint8_t HIDReportData[HIDReportSize]; + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = REQ_GetDescriptor, + .wValue = (HID_DTYPE_Report << 8), + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = HIDReportSize, + }; + + /* Select the control pipe for the request transfer */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + /* Send control request to retrieve the HID report from the attached device */ + if (USB_Host_SendControlRequest(HIDReportData) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ParseControlError; + + /* Send the HID report to the parser for processing */ + if (USB_ProcessHIDReport(HIDReportData, HIDReportSize, &HIDReportInfo) != HID_PARSE_Successful) + return ParseError; + + return ParseSuccessful; +} + +/** Callback for the HID Report Parser. This function is called each time the HID report parser is about to store + * an IN, OUT or FEATURE item into the HIDReportInfo structure. To save on RAM, we are able to filter out items + * we aren't interested in (preventing us from being able to extract them later on, but saving on the RAM they would + * have occupied). + * + * \param[in] CurrentItem Pointer to the item the HID report parser is currently working with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the item should be stored into the HID report structure, \c false if it should be discarded + */ +bool CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem(HID_ReportItem_t* const CurrentItem) +{ + bool IsMouse = false; + + /* Iterate through the item's collection path, until either the root collection node or a collection with the + * Mouse Usage is found - this prevents Joysticks, which use identical descriptors except for the Joystick usage + * parent node, from being erroneously treated as a mouse + */ + for (HID_CollectionPath_t* CurrPath = CurrentItem->CollectionPath; CurrPath != NULL; CurrPath = CurrPath->Parent) + { + if ((CurrPath->Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_GENERIC_DCTRL) && + (CurrPath->Usage.Usage == USAGE_MOUSE)) + { + IsMouse = true; + break; + } + } + + /* If a collection with the mouse usage was not found, indicate that we are not interested in this item */ + if (!IsMouse) + return false; + + /* Check the attributes of the current mouse item - see if we are interested in it or not; + * only store BUTTON and GENERIC_DESKTOP_CONTROL items into the Processed HID Report + * structure to save RAM and ignore the rest + */ + return ((CurrentItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_BUTTON) || + (CurrentItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_GENERIC_DCTRL)); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/HIDReport.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/HIDReport.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1296f57a71 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/HIDReport.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for HIDReport.c. + */ + +#ifndef _HID_REPORT_H_ +#define _HID_REPORT_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "MouseHostWithParser.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage for a Mouse. */ + #define USAGE_MOUSE 0x02 + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage Page value for a toggle button. */ + #define USAGE_PAGE_BUTTON 0x09 + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage Page value for a Generic Desktop Control. */ + #define USAGE_PAGE_GENERIC_DCTRL 0x01 + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage value for a X axis movement. */ + #define USAGE_X 0x30 + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage value for a Y axis movement. */ + #define USAGE_Y 0x31 + + /** HID Report Descriptor Usage value for a Scroll Wheel movement. */ + #define USAGE_SCROLL_WHEEL 0x38 + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref GetHIDReportData() function. */ + enum MouseHostWithParser_GetHIDReportDataCodes_t + { + ParseSuccessful = 0, /**< HID report descriptor parsed successfully */ + ParseError = 1, /**< Failed to fully process the HID report descriptor */ + ParseControlError = 2, /**< Control error occurred while trying to read the device HID descriptor */ + }; + + /* External Variables: */ + extern uint16_t HIDReportSize; + extern HID_ReportInfo_t HIDReportInfo; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t GetHIDReportData(void); + + bool CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem(HID_ReportItem_t* const CurrentItem); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4ad4d580e7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.c @@ -0,0 +1,289 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the MouseHostWithParser demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "MouseHostWithParser.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Mouse HID Parser Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + MouseHost_Task(); + + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Attached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Unattached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Getting Config Data.\r\n")); + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Get and process the configuration descriptor data */ + if ((ErrorCode = ProcessConfigurationDescriptor()) != SuccessfulConfigRead) + { + if (ErrorCode == ControlError) + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Get Configuration).\r\n")); + else + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Invalid Device.\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* Set the device configuration to the first configuration (rarely do devices use multiple configurations) */ + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Set Configuration).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + printf_P(PSTR("Processing HID Report (Size %d Bytes).\r\n"), HIDReportSize); + + /* Get and process the device's first HID report descriptor */ + if ((ErrorCode = GetHIDReportData()) != ParseSuccessful) + { + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Report Parse Error.\r\n")); + + if (!(HIDReportInfo.TotalReportItems)) + puts_P(PSTR("Not a valid Mouse." ESC_FG_WHITE)); + else + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Mouse Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Task to read and process the HID report descriptor and HID reports from the device and display the + * results onto the board LEDs. + */ +void MouseHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Select and unfreeze mouse data pipe */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(MOUSE_DATA_IN_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Check to see if a packet has been received */ + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + { + /* Check if data has been received from the attached mouse */ + if (Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed()) + { + /* Create buffer big enough for the report */ + uint8_t MouseReport[Pipe_BytesInPipe()]; + + /* Load in the mouse report */ + Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(MouseReport, Pipe_BytesInPipe(), NULL); + + /* Process the read in mouse report from the device */ + ProcessMouseReport(MouseReport); + } + + /* Clear the IN endpoint, ready for next data packet */ + Pipe_ClearIN(); + } + + /* Freeze mouse data pipe */ + Pipe_Freeze(); +} + +/** Processes a read HID report from an attached mouse, extracting out elements via the HID parser results + * as required and displays movement and button presses on the board LEDs. + * + * \param[in] MouseReport Pointer to a HID report from an attached mouse device + */ +void ProcessMouseReport(uint8_t* MouseReport) +{ + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS; + + /* Check each HID report item in turn, looking for mouse X/Y/button reports */ + for (uint8_t ReportNumber = 0; ReportNumber < HIDReportInfo.TotalReportItems; ReportNumber++) + { + /* Create a temporary item pointer to the next report item */ + HID_ReportItem_t* ReportItem = &HIDReportInfo.ReportItems[ReportNumber]; + + bool FoundData; + + if ((ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_BUTTON) && + (ReportItem->ItemType == HID_REPORT_ITEM_In)) + { + /* Get the mouse button value */ + FoundData = USB_GetHIDReportItemInfo(MouseReport, ReportItem); + + /* For multi-report devices - if the requested data was not in the issued report, continue */ + if (!(FoundData)) + continue; + + /* If button is pressed, all LEDs are turned on */ + if (ReportItem->Value) + LEDMask = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + else if ((ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_GENERIC_DCTRL) && + (ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Usage == USAGE_SCROLL_WHEEL) && + (ReportItem->ItemType == HID_REPORT_ITEM_In)) + { + /* Get the mouse wheel value if it is contained within the current + * report, if not, skip to the next item in the parser list + */ + if (!(USB_GetHIDReportItemInfo(MouseReport, ReportItem))) + continue; + + int16_t WheelDelta = HID_ALIGN_DATA(ReportItem, int16_t); + + if (WheelDelta) + LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | ((WheelDelta > 0) ? LEDS_LED3 : LEDS_LED4)); + } + else if ((ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Page == USAGE_PAGE_GENERIC_DCTRL) && + ((ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Usage == USAGE_X) || + (ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Usage == USAGE_Y)) && + (ReportItem->ItemType == HID_REPORT_ITEM_In)) + { + /* Get the mouse relative position value */ + FoundData = USB_GetHIDReportItemInfo(MouseReport, ReportItem); + + /* For multi-report devices - if the requested data was not in the issued report, continue */ + if (!(FoundData)) + continue; + + int16_t DeltaMovement = HID_ALIGN_DATA(ReportItem, int16_t); + + /* Check to see if a (non-zero) delta movement has been indicated */ + if (DeltaMovement) + { + /* Determine if the report is for the X or Y delta movement, light LEDs as appropriate */ + if (ReportItem->Attributes.Usage.Usage == USAGE_X) + LEDMask |= ((DeltaMovement > 0) ? LEDS_LED1 : LEDS_LED2); + else + LEDMask |= ((DeltaMovement > 0) ? LEDS_LED3 : LEDS_LED4); + } + } + } + + /* Display the button information on the board LEDs */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8812cacbea --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.h @@ -0,0 +1,83 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for MouseHostWithParser.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MOUSE_HOST_H_ +#define _MOUSE_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + #include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + #include "HIDReport.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void MouseHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + + void ProcessMouseReport(uint8_t* MouseReport); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9b1b7d055c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.txt @@ -0,0 +1,71 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Mouse Host With HID Descriptor Parser Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Mouse host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Mouse host, for USB mice using + * the standard mouse HID profile. It uses a HID parser for the HID + * reports, allowing for correct operation across all USB mice. This + * demo supports mice with a single HID report. + * + * Mouse and scroll wheel movement and button presses are displayed + * on the board LEDs. On connection to a USB mouse, the report items + * will be processed and printed as a formatted list through the USART + * before the mouse is fully enumerated. + * + * Currently only single interface mice are supported. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e06dbea4ae --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,52 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Mouse HID (with parser) Host Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.mouse_parser.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.mouse_parser"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.mouse_parser" caption="Mouse HID (with parser) Host Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Mouse HID Host demo with HID parser, implementing a basic USB mouse host that can display movement data on the board LEDs. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="MouseHostWithParser.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="MouseHostWithParser.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="ConfigDescriptor.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="HIDReport.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="MouseHostWithParser.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="ConfigDescriptor.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="HIDReport.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f12fda279d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Mouse Host Demo (Using HID Descriptor Parser)" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..df0fc00fce --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/MouseHostWithParser/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = MouseHostWithParser +SRC = $(TARGET).c ConfigDescriptor.c HIDReport.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/ConfigDescriptor.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/ConfigDescriptor.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6e92b1760d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/ConfigDescriptor.c @@ -0,0 +1,177 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + +/** Interface number for the bidirectional Printer interface found within the device. */ +uint8_t PrinterInterfaceNumber; + +/** Interface Alternate Setting number for the bidirectional Printer interface found within the device. */ +uint8_t PrinterAltSetting; + +/** Reads and processes an attached device's descriptors, to determine compatibility and pipe configurations. This + * routine will read in the entire configuration descriptor, and configure the hosts pipes to correctly communicate + * with compatible devices. + * + * This routine searches for a bidirectional Printer interface descriptor containing bulk IN and OUT data endpoints. + * + * \return An error code from the \ref PrinterHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t enum. + */ +uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void) +{ + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + void* CurrConfigLocation = ConfigDescriptorData; + uint16_t CurrConfigBytesRem; + + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* PrinterInterface = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Retrieve the entire configuration descriptor into the allocated buffer */ + switch (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &CurrConfigBytesRem, ConfigDescriptorData, sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData))) + { + case HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful: + break; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_InvalidData: + return InvalidConfigDataReturned; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_BuffOverflow: + return DescriptorTooLarge; + default: + return ControlError; + } + + while (!(DataINEndpoint) || !(DataOUTEndpoint)) + { + /* See if we've found a likely compatible interface, and if there is an endpoint within that interface */ + if (!(PrinterInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextPrinterInterfaceBulkDataEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Get the next Printer interface from the configuration descriptor */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextBidirectionalPrinterInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Save the interface in case we need to refer back to it later */ + PrinterInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Clear any found endpoints */ + DataINEndpoint = NULL; + DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Skip the remainder of the loop as we have not found an endpoint yet */ + continue; + } + + /* Retrieve the endpoint address from the endpoint descriptor */ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* If the endpoint is a IN type endpoint */ + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + else + DataOUTEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + + /* Save Printer interface details for later use */ + PrinterInterfaceNumber = PrinterInterface->InterfaceNumber; + PrinterAltSetting = PrinterInterface->AlternateSetting; + + /* Configure the Printer data IN pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(PRINTER_DATA_IN_PIPE, EP_TYPE_BULK, DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + + /* Configure the Printer data OUT pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(PRINTER_DATA_OUT_PIPE, EP_TYPE_BULK, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + + /* Valid data found, return success */ + return SuccessfulConfigRead; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Bidirectional Printer Interface descriptor of the current Printer interface, + * aborting the search if the end of the descriptors is found. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextBidirectionalPrinterInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Check the descriptor class, subclass and protocol, break out if correct value interface found */ + if ((Interface->Class == PRNT_CSCP_PrinterClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == PRNT_CSCP_PrinterSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == PRNT_CSCP_BidirectionalProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Bulk Endpoint descriptor of the current Printer interface, aborting the + * search if another interface descriptor is found before the next endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextPrinterInterfaceBulkDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* Endpoint = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* Check the endpoint type, break out if correct BULK type endpoint found */ + if ((Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK) == EP_TYPE_BULK) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/ConfigDescriptor.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/ConfigDescriptor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..34c7785982 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/ConfigDescriptor.h @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#ifndef _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ +#define _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "PrinterHost.h" + #include "Lib/PrinterCommands.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Pipe address of the Printer data IN pipe. */ + #define PRINTER_DATA_IN_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Pipe address of the Printer data OUT pipe. */ + #define PRINTER_DATA_OUT_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref ProcessConfigurationDescriptor() function. */ + enum PrinterHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t + { + SuccessfulConfigRead = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully */ + ControlError = 1, /**< A control request to the device failed to complete successfully */ + DescriptorTooLarge = 2, /**< The device's Configuration Descriptor is too large to process */ + InvalidConfigDataReturned = 3, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor */ + NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 4, /**< A compatible interface with the required endpoints was not found */ + }; + + /* External Variables: */ + /** Interface index of the Bidirectional Printer interface within the device, once the Configuration + * Descriptor has been processed. + */ + extern uint8_t PrinterInterfaceNumber; + + /** Interface Alternate Setting index of the Bidirectional Printer interface within the device, once + * the Configuration Descriptor has been processed. + */ + extern uint8_t PrinterAltSetting; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void); + + uint8_t DComp_NextBidirectionalPrinterInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextPrinterInterfaceBulkDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/Lib/PrinterCommands.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/Lib/PrinterCommands.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7507891259 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/Lib/PrinterCommands.c @@ -0,0 +1,162 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Printer Device commands, to send/receive data to and from an attached USB + * printer, and to send and receive Printer Class control requests. + */ + +#include "PrinterCommands.h" + +/** Sends the given data directly to the printer via the data endpoints, for the sending of print commands in printer + * languages accepted by the attached printer (e.g. PCL). + * + * \param[in] PrinterCommands Pointer to the data to send to the attached printer + * \param[in] CommandSize Size of the data to send to the attached printer + * + * \return A value from the Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t Printer_SendData(const void* const PrinterCommands, + const uint16_t CommandSize) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PRINTER_DATA_OUT_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(PrinterCommands, CommandSize, NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + Pipe_WaitUntilReady(); + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +/** Issues a Printer class Get Device ID command to the attached device, to retrieve the device ID string (which indicates + * the accepted printer languages, the printer's model and other pertinent information). + * + * \param[out] DeviceIDString Pointer to the destination where the returned string should be stored + * \param[in] BufferSize Size in bytes of the allocated buffer for the returned Device ID string + * + * \return A value from the USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t Printer_GetDeviceID(char* DeviceIDString, + const uint16_t BufferSize) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + uint16_t DeviceIDStringLength = 0; + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = PRNT_REQ_GetDeviceID, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = PrinterInterfaceNumber, + .wLength = sizeof(DeviceIDStringLength), + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(&DeviceIDStringLength)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ErrorCode; + + if (!(DeviceIDStringLength)) + { + DeviceIDString[0] = 0x00; + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; + } + + DeviceIDStringLength = SwapEndian_16(DeviceIDStringLength); + + if (DeviceIDStringLength > BufferSize) + DeviceIDStringLength = BufferSize; + + USB_ControlRequest.wLength = DeviceIDStringLength; + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(DeviceIDString)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ErrorCode; + + /* Move string back two characters to remove the string length value from the start of the array */ + memmove(&DeviceIDString[0], &DeviceIDString[2], DeviceIDStringLength - 2); + + DeviceIDString[DeviceIDStringLength - 2] = 0x00; + + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; +} + +/** Issues a Printer class Get Port Status command to the attached device, to retrieve the current status flags of the + * printer. + * + * \param[out] PortStatus Pointer to the destination where the printer's status flag values should be stored + * + * \return A value from the USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t Printer_GetPortStatus(uint8_t* const PortStatus) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = PRNT_REQ_GetPortStatus, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = PrinterInterfaceNumber, + .wLength = sizeof(uint8_t), + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(PortStatus); +} + +/** Issues a Printer class Soft Reset command to the attached device, to reset the printer ready for new input without + * physically cycling the printer's power. + * + * \return A value from the USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t Printer_SoftReset(void) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = PRNT_REQ_SoftReset, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = PrinterInterfaceNumber, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(NULL); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/Lib/PrinterCommands.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/Lib/PrinterCommands.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f29b18e454 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/Lib/PrinterCommands.h @@ -0,0 +1,56 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for PrinterCommands.c. + */ + +#ifndef _PRINTER_COMMANDS_H_ +#define _PRINTER_COMMANDS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "../PrinterHost.h" + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t Printer_SendData(const void* const PrinterCommands, + const uint16_t CommandSize); + uint8_t Printer_GetDeviceID(char* DeviceIDString, + const uint16_t BufferSize); + uint8_t Printer_GetPortStatus(uint8_t* const PortStatus); + uint8_t Printer_SoftReset(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/PrinterHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/PrinterHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..44e8f12743 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/PrinterHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,226 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the PrinterHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "PrinterHost.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Printer Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + PrinterHost_Task(); + + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Attached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Getting Config Data.\r\n")); + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Get and process the configuration descriptor data */ + if ((ErrorCode = ProcessConfigurationDescriptor()) != SuccessfulConfigRead) + { + if (ErrorCode == ControlError) + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Get Configuration).\r\n")); + else + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Invalid Device.\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n"), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* Set the device configuration to the first configuration (rarely do devices use multiple configurations) */ + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Set Configuration).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* Some printers use alternate settings to determine the communication protocol used - if so, send a SetInterface + * request to switch to the interface alternate setting with the Bidirectional protocol */ + if (PrinterAltSetting) + { + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SetInterfaceAltSetting(PrinterInterfaceNumber, PrinterAltSetting)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Set Interface).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Retrieving Device ID...\r\n")); + + char DeviceIDString[300]; + if ((ErrorCode = Printer_GetDeviceID(DeviceIDString, sizeof(DeviceIDString))) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Get Device ID).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + printf_P(PSTR("Printer Device ID: %s\r\n"), DeviceIDString); + + puts_P(PSTR("Printer Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Task to manage an enumerated USB printer once connected, to display device + * information and print a test PCL page. + */ +void PrinterHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Indicate device busy via the status LEDs */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + + char TestPageData[] = "\033%-12345X\033E" "LUFA PCL Test Page" "\033E\033%-12345X"; + uint16_t TestPageLength = strlen(TestPageData); + + printf_P(PSTR("Sending Test Page (%d bytes)...\r\n"), TestPageLength); + + /* Send the test page to the attached printer */ + if ((ErrorCode = Printer_SendData(&TestPageData, TestPageLength)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Error Sending Test Page.\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Test Page Sent.\r\n")); + + /* Indicate device no longer busy */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/PrinterHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/PrinterHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c1daa6247e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/PrinterHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,88 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for PrinterHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MASS_STORE_HOST_H_ +#define _MASS_STORE_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + #include "Lib/PrinterCommands.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 + + /* External Variables: */ + extern uint8_t PrinterInterfaceNumber; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void PrinterHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/PrinterHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/PrinterHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e2a4820583 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/PrinterHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Printer Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Printer Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Bidirectional Protocol</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Printer Class Specification \n + * PCL Language Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Printer host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a USB Printer host, for USB printers using + * the bidirectional data encapsulation protocol and PCL language. + * + * Upon connection of a compatible printer, the printer's device ID is sent + * to the AVR's serial port, and a simple test page is printed using the PCL + * printer language. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7f86063604 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,53 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Printer Host Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.printer.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.printer"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.printer" caption="Printer Host Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Printer Host demo, implementing a basic USB printer host that can send raw printer control data to an attached device. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="Printer Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="PrinterHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="PrinterHost.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="ConfigDescriptor.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="PrinterHost.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="ConfigDescriptor.h"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/PrinterCommands.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/PrinterCommands.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3fcf03b2b9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Printer Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bcaa0b4737 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/PrinterHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = PrinterHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c ConfigDescriptor.c Lib/PrinterCommands.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/ConfigDescriptor.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/ConfigDescriptor.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c7a45da09e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/ConfigDescriptor.c @@ -0,0 +1,235 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Configuration Descriptor processing routines, to determine the correct pipe configurations + * needed to communication with an attached USB device. Descriptors are special computer-readable structures + * which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + +/** Reads and processes an attached device's descriptors, to determine compatibility and pipe configurations. This + * routine will read in the entire configuration descriptor, and configure the hosts pipes to correctly communicate + * with compatible devices. + * + * This routine searches for a RNDIS interface descriptor containing bulk data IN and OUT endpoints, and an interrupt event endpoint. + * + * \return An error code from the \ref RNDISHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t enum. + */ +uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void) +{ + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + void* CurrConfigLocation = ConfigDescriptorData; + uint16_t CurrConfigBytesRem; + + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* RNDISControlInterface = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* NotificationEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Retrieve the entire configuration descriptor into the allocated buffer */ + switch (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &CurrConfigBytesRem, ConfigDescriptorData, sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData))) + { + case HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful: + break; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_InvalidData: + return InvalidConfigDataReturned; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_BuffOverflow: + return DescriptorTooLarge; + default: + return ControlError; + } + + while (!(DataINEndpoint) || !(DataOUTEndpoint) || !(NotificationEndpoint)) + { + /* See if we've found a likely compatible interface, and if there is an endpoint within that interface */ + if (!(RNDISControlInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextCDCDataInterfaceEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Check if we have already found the control interface's notification endpoint or not */ + if (NotificationEndpoint) + { + /* Get the next RNDIS data interface from the configuration descriptor */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextCDCDataInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Clear any found endpoints */ + DataINEndpoint = NULL; + DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + } + else + { + /* Get the next RNDIS control interface from the configuration descriptor */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextCDCControlInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Save the interface in case we need to refer back to it later */ + RNDISControlInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Clear any found endpoints */ + NotificationEndpoint = NULL; + } + + /* Skip the remainder of the loop as we have not found an endpoint yet */ + continue; + } + + /* Retrieve the endpoint address from the endpoint descriptor */ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* If the endpoint is a IN type endpoint */ + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + { + /* Check if the found endpoint is a interrupt or bulk type descriptor */ + if ((EndpointData->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK) == EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT) + NotificationEndpoint = EndpointData; + else + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + else + { + DataOUTEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + } + + /* Configure the RNDIS data IN pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(RNDIS_DATA_IN_PIPE, EP_TYPE_BULK, DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + + /* Configure the RNDIS data OUT pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(RNDIS_DATA_OUT_PIPE, EP_TYPE_BULK, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + + /* Configure the RNDIS notification pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(RNDIS_NOTIFICATION_PIPE, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, NotificationEndpoint->EndpointAddress, NotificationEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + Pipe_SetInterruptPeriod(NotificationEndpoint->PollingIntervalMS); + + /* Valid data found, return success */ + return SuccessfulConfigRead; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interface descriptor of the correct CDC control Class, Subclass and Protocol values. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextCDCControlInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Check the CDC descriptor class, subclass and protocol, break out if correct control interface found */ + if ((Interface->Class == CDC_CSCP_CDCClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == CDC_CSCP_VendorSpecificProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interface descriptor of the correct CDC data Class, Subclass and Protocol values. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextCDCDataInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Check the CDC descriptor class, subclass and protocol, break out if correct data interface found */ + if ((Interface->Class == CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next bulk IN or OUT endpoint, or interrupt IN endpoint within the current interface, + * aborting the search if another interface descriptor is found before the required endpoint (so that it may be compared + * using a different comparator to determine if it is another CDC class interface). + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextCDCDataInterfaceEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* Endpoint = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* Check the endpoint type, break out if correct BULK or INTERRUPT type endpoint found */ + if (((Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK) == EP_TYPE_BULK) || + ((Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK) == EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/ConfigDescriptor.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/ConfigDescriptor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0be574b588 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/ConfigDescriptor.h @@ -0,0 +1,73 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ConfigDescriptor.c. + */ + +#ifndef _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ +#define _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "RNDISEthernetHost.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Pipe address for the RNDIS data IN pipe. */ + #define RNDIS_DATA_IN_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Pipe address for the RNDIS data OUT pipe. */ + #define RNDIS_DATA_OUT_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /** Pipe address for the RNDIS notification IN pipe. */ + #define RNDIS_NOTIFICATION_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_IN | 3) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref ProcessConfigurationDescriptor() function. */ + enum RNDISHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t + { + SuccessfulConfigRead = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully */ + ControlError = 1, /**< A control request to the device failed to complete successfully */ + DescriptorTooLarge = 2, /**< The device's Configuration Descriptor is too large to process */ + InvalidConfigDataReturned = 3, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor */ + NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 4, /**< A compatible interface with the required endpoints was not found */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void); + + uint8_t DComp_NextCDCControlInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextCDCDataInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextCDCDataInterfaceEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/Lib/RNDISCommands.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/Lib/RNDISCommands.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..137648c2cf --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/Lib/RNDISCommands.c @@ -0,0 +1,311 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * RNDIS Device commands, to issue RNDIS commands to the device for + * the control and data transfer between the host and RNDIS device. + */ + +#include "RNDISCommands.h" + +/** Current RNDIS Request ID, for associating sent commands with received data */ +uint32_t RequestID = 0; + + +/** Function to send the given encapsulated RNDIS command to the device. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Source command data buffer to send to the device + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send + * + * \return A value from the USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t RNDIS_SendEncapsulatedCommand(void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = RNDIS_REQ_SendEncapsulatedCommand, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = Length, + }; + + /* Select the control pipe for the request transfer */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(Buffer); +} + +/** Function to receive the given encapsulated RNDIS response from the device. + * + * \param[out] Buffer Destination command data buffer to write read data from the device to + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read + * + * \return A value from the USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t RNDIS_GetEncapsulatedResponse(void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = RNDIS_REQ_GetEncapsulatedResponse, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = Length, + }; + + /* Select the control pipe for the request transfer */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(Buffer); +} + +/** Sends a RNDIS KEEPALIVE command to the device, to ensure that it does not enter standby mode after periods + * of long inactivity. + * + * \return A value from the USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum or RNDIS_COMMAND_FAILED if the device returned a + * logical command failure + */ +uint8_t RNDIS_SendKeepAlive(void) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + RNDIS_KeepAlive_Message_t KeepAliveMessage; + RNDIS_KeepAlive_Complete_t KeepAliveMessageResponse; + + KeepAliveMessage.MessageType = REMOTE_NDIS_KEEPALIVE_MSG; + KeepAliveMessage.MessageLength = sizeof(RNDIS_KeepAlive_Message_t); + KeepAliveMessage.RequestId = RequestID++; + + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_SendEncapsulatedCommand(&KeepAliveMessage, + sizeof(RNDIS_KeepAlive_Message_t))) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_GetEncapsulatedResponse(&KeepAliveMessageResponse, + sizeof(RNDIS_KeepAlive_Complete_t))) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; +} + +/** Initializes the attached RNDIS device's RNDIS interface. + * + * \param[in] HostMaxPacketSize Size of the packet buffer on the host + * \param[out] DeviceMaxPacketSize Pointer to where the packet buffer size of the device is to be stored + * + * \return A value from the USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum or RNDIS_COMMAND_FAILED if the device returned a + * logical command failure + */ +uint8_t RNDIS_InitializeDevice(const uint16_t HostMaxPacketSize, + uint16_t* const DeviceMaxPacketSize) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + RNDIS_Initialize_Message_t InitMessage; + RNDIS_Initialize_Complete_t InitMessageResponse; + + InitMessage.MessageType = REMOTE_NDIS_INITIALIZE_MSG; + InitMessage.MessageLength = sizeof(RNDIS_Initialize_Message_t); + InitMessage.RequestId = RequestID++; + + InitMessage.MajorVersion = REMOTE_NDIS_VERSION_MAJOR; + InitMessage.MinorVersion = REMOTE_NDIS_VERSION_MINOR; + InitMessage.MaxTransferSize = HostMaxPacketSize; + + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_SendEncapsulatedCommand(&InitMessage, + sizeof(RNDIS_Initialize_Message_t))) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_GetEncapsulatedResponse(&InitMessageResponse, + sizeof(RNDIS_Initialize_Complete_t))) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + if (InitMessageResponse.Status != REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_SUCCESS) + return RNDIS_COMMAND_FAILED; + + *DeviceMaxPacketSize = InitMessageResponse.MaxTransferSize; + + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; +} + +/** Sets a given RNDIS property of an attached RNDIS device. + * + * \param[in] Oid OID number of the parameter to set + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to where the property data is to be sourced from + * \param[in] Length Length in bytes of the property data to sent to the device + * + * \return A value from the USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum or RNDIS_COMMAND_FAILED if the device returned a + * logical command failure + */ +uint8_t RNDIS_SetRNDISProperty(const uint32_t Oid, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + struct + { + RNDIS_Set_Message_t SetMessage; + uint8_t ContiguousBuffer[Length]; + } SetMessageData; + + RNDIS_Set_Complete_t SetMessageResponse; + + SetMessageData.SetMessage.MessageType = REMOTE_NDIS_SET_MSG; + SetMessageData.SetMessage.MessageLength = sizeof(RNDIS_Set_Message_t) + Length; + SetMessageData.SetMessage.RequestId = RequestID++; + + SetMessageData.SetMessage.Oid = Oid; + SetMessageData.SetMessage.InformationBufferLength = Length; + SetMessageData.SetMessage.InformationBufferOffset = (sizeof(RNDIS_Set_Message_t) - sizeof(RNDIS_Message_Header_t)); + SetMessageData.SetMessage.DeviceVcHandle = 0; + + memcpy(SetMessageData.ContiguousBuffer, Buffer, Length); + + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_SendEncapsulatedCommand(&SetMessageData, + SetMessageData.SetMessage.MessageLength)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_GetEncapsulatedResponse(&SetMessageResponse, + sizeof(RNDIS_Set_Complete_t))) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + if (SetMessageResponse.Status != REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_SUCCESS) + return RNDIS_COMMAND_FAILED; + + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; +} + +/** Gets a given RNDIS property of an attached RNDIS device. + * + * \param[in] Oid OID number of the parameter to get + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to where the property data is to be written to + * \param[in] MaxLength Length in bytes of the destination buffer size + * + * \return A value from the USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum or RNDIS_COMMAND_FAILED if the device returned a + * logical command failure + */ +uint8_t RNDIS_QueryRNDISProperty(const uint32_t Oid, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t MaxLength) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + RNDIS_Query_Message_t QueryMessage; + + struct + { + RNDIS_Query_Complete_t QueryMessageResponse; + uint8_t ContiguousBuffer[MaxLength]; + } QueryMessageResponseData; + + QueryMessage.MessageType = REMOTE_NDIS_QUERY_MSG; + QueryMessage.MessageLength = sizeof(RNDIS_Query_Message_t); + QueryMessage.RequestId = RequestID++; + + QueryMessage.Oid = Oid; + QueryMessage.InformationBufferLength = 0; + QueryMessage.InformationBufferOffset = 0; + QueryMessage.DeviceVcHandle = 0; + + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_SendEncapsulatedCommand(&QueryMessage, + sizeof(RNDIS_Query_Message_t))) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_GetEncapsulatedResponse(&QueryMessageResponseData, + sizeof(QueryMessageResponseData))) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + if (QueryMessageResponseData.QueryMessageResponse.Status != REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_SUCCESS) + return RNDIS_COMMAND_FAILED; + + memcpy(Buffer, &QueryMessageResponseData.ContiguousBuffer, MaxLength); + + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; +} + +/** Retrieves the size of a received packet, discarding the remainder of the RNDIS packet header to leave only the + * packet contents for processing by the host. + * + * \param[out] PacketLength Size of the packet currently in the pipe + * + * \return A value from the Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t RNDIS_GetPacketLength(uint16_t* const PacketLength) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(RNDIS_DATA_IN_PIPE); + Pipe_SetPipeToken(PIPE_TOKEN_IN); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (!(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + *PacketLength = 0; + Pipe_Freeze(); + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; + } + + RNDIS_Packet_Message_t DeviceMessage; + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(&DeviceMessage, sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t), NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + *PacketLength = (uint16_t)DeviceMessage.DataLength; + + Pipe_Discard_Stream(DeviceMessage.DataOffset - (sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t) - sizeof(RNDIS_Message_Header_t)), + NULL); + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/Lib/RNDISCommands.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/Lib/RNDISCommands.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..44dc4e7468 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/Lib/RNDISCommands.h @@ -0,0 +1,70 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for RNDISCommands.c. + */ + +#ifndef _RNDIS_COMMANDS_H_ +#define _RNDIS_COMMANDS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <stdio.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "../RNDISEthernetHost.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Additional error code for RNDIS functions when a device returns a logical command failure. */ + #define RNDIS_COMMAND_FAILED 0xC0 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t RNDIS_SendEncapsulatedCommand(void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Length); + uint8_t RNDIS_GetEncapsulatedResponse(void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Length); + + uint8_t RNDIS_SendKeepAlive(void); + uint8_t RNDIS_InitializeDevice(const uint16_t HostMaxPacketSize, + uint16_t* const DeviceMaxPacketSize); + uint8_t RNDIS_SetRNDISProperty(const uint32_t Oid, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t Length); + uint8_t RNDIS_QueryRNDISProperty(const uint32_t Oid, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t MaxLength); + uint8_t RNDIS_GetPacketLength(uint16_t* const PacketLength); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/RNDISEthernetHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/RNDISEthernetHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..68d05b95e7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/RNDISEthernetHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,249 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the RNDISEthernetHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "RNDISEthernetHost.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "RNDIS Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + RNDISHost_Task(); + + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Attached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Getting Config Data.\r\n")); + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Get and process the configuration descriptor data */ + if ((ErrorCode = ProcessConfigurationDescriptor()) != SuccessfulConfigRead) + { + if (ErrorCode == ControlError) + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Get Configuration).\r\n")); + else + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Invalid Device.\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* Set the device configuration to the first configuration (rarely do devices use multiple configurations) */ + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Set Configuration).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + uint16_t DeviceMaxPacketSize; + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_InitializeDevice(1024, &DeviceMaxPacketSize)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Error Initializing Device.\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + printf_P(PSTR("Device Max Transfer Size: %lu bytes.\r\n"), DeviceMaxPacketSize); + + /* We set the default filter to only receive packets we would be interested in */ + uint32_t PacketFilter = (REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_DIRECTED | REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_BROADCAST | REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_ALL_MULTICAST); + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_SetRNDISProperty(OID_GEN_CURRENT_PACKET_FILTER, + &PacketFilter, sizeof(PacketFilter))) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Error Setting Device Packet Filter.\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + uint32_t VendorID; + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_QueryRNDISProperty(OID_GEN_VENDOR_ID, + &VendorID, sizeof(VendorID))) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Error Getting Vendor ID.\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + printf_P(PSTR("Device Vendor ID: 0x%08lX\r\n"), VendorID); + + puts_P(PSTR("RNDIS Device Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Task to read in data received from the attached RNDIS device and print it to the serial port. + */ +void RNDISHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + + uint16_t PacketLength; + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_GetPacketLength(&PacketLength)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Packet Reception Error.\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + return; + } + + if (!(PacketLength)) + return; + + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + printf_P(PSTR("***PACKET (Size %d)***\r\n"), PacketLength); + + if (PacketLength > 1024) + { + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Packet too large.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + Pipe_Discard_Stream(PacketLength, NULL); + } + else + { + uint8_t PacketBuffer[PacketLength]; + + Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(&PacketBuffer, PacketLength, NULL); + + for (uint16_t i = 0; i < PacketLength; i++) + printf("0x%02x ", PacketBuffer[i]); + } + + Pipe_ClearIN(); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + printf("\r\n\r\n"); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/RNDISEthernetHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/RNDISEthernetHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ee8b3a8398 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/RNDISEthernetHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,85 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for RNDISEthernetHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _RNDIS_HOST_H_ +#define _RNDIS_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + #include "Lib/RNDISCommands.h" + + #include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void RNDISHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/RNDISHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/RNDISHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e9edd6d668 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/RNDISHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,63 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage RNDIS Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Remote NDIS (Microsoft Proprietary CDC Class Networking Standard)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>Microsoft RNDIS Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * RNDIS host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a RNDIS Ethernet host, for USB devices such as + * modems. + * + * This demo will enumerate an attached USB RNDIS device, print out its vendor ID + * and any received packets in raw form through the serial USART. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..38f71272e5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,53 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="RNDIS Ethernet Host Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.rndis.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.rndis"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.rndis" caption="RNDIS Ethernet Host Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Microsoft RNDIS Ethernet Host demo, implementing a RNDIS host that can send and receive Ethernet data to and from an attached device. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="RNDIS Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="RNDISHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="RNDISEthernetHost.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="ConfigDescriptor.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="RNDISEthernetHost.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="ConfigDescriptor.h"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/RNDISCommands.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/RNDISCommands.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..50e1cc59ad --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - RNDIS Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..eaaf3ba214 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/RNDISEthernetHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = RNDISEthernetHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c ConfigDescriptor.c Lib/RNDISCommands.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/ConfigDescriptor.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/ConfigDescriptor.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8b48257581 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/ConfigDescriptor.c @@ -0,0 +1,190 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Configuration Descriptor processing routines, to determine the correct pipe configurations + * needed to communication with an attached USB device. Descriptors are special computer-readable structures + * which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + +/** Reads and processes an attached device's descriptors, to determine compatibility and pipe configurations. This + * routine will read in the entire configuration descriptor, and configure the hosts pipes to correctly communicate + * with compatible devices. + * + * This routine searches for a SI interface descriptor containing bulk IN and OUT data endpoints. + * + * \return An error code from the \ref StillImageHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t enum. + */ +uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void) +{ + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + void* CurrConfigLocation = ConfigDescriptorData; + uint16_t CurrConfigBytesRem; + + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* StillImageInterface = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EventsEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Retrieve the entire configuration descriptor into the allocated buffer */ + switch (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &CurrConfigBytesRem, ConfigDescriptorData, sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData))) + { + case HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful: + break; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_InvalidData: + return InvalidConfigDataReturned; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_BuffOverflow: + return DescriptorTooLarge; + default: + return ControlError; + } + + while (!(DataINEndpoint) || !(DataOUTEndpoint)) + { + /* See if we've found a likely compatible interface, and if there is an endpoint within that interface */ + if (!(StillImageInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextStillImageInterfaceDataEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Get the next Still Image interface from the configuration descriptor */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextStillImageInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Save the interface in case we need to refer back to it later */ + StillImageInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Clear any found endpoints */ + DataINEndpoint = NULL; + DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + EventsEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Skip the remainder of the loop as we have not found an endpoint yet */ + continue; + } + + /* Retrieve the endpoint address from the endpoint descriptor */ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* If the endpoint is a IN type endpoint */ + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + { + /* Check if the found endpoint is a interrupt or bulk type descriptor */ + if ((EndpointData->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK) == EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT) + EventsEndpoint = EndpointData; + else + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + else + { + DataOUTEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + } + + /* Configure the Still Image data IN pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(SIMAGE_DATA_IN_PIPE, EP_TYPE_BULK, DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + + /* Configure the Still Image data OUT pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(SIMAGE_DATA_OUT_PIPE, EP_TYPE_BULK, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + + /* Configure the Still Image events pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(SIMAGE_EVENTS_PIPE, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, EventsEndpoint->EndpointAddress, EventsEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + Pipe_SetInterruptPeriod(EventsEndpoint->PollingIntervalMS); + + /* Valid data found, return success */ + return SuccessfulConfigRead; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interface descriptor of the correct Still Image Class, Subclass and Protocol values. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextStillImageInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Check the descriptor class, subclass and protocol, break out if correct interface found */ + if ((Interface->Class == SI_CSCP_StillImageClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == SI_CSCP_StillImageSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == SI_CSCP_BulkOnlyProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interrupt or Bulk Endpoint descriptor of the current SI interface, aborting the + * search if another interface descriptor is found before the next endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextStillImageInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* Endpoint = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* Check the endpoint type, break out if correct BULK or INTERRUPT type endpoint found */ + if (((Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK) == EP_TYPE_BULK) || + ((Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK) == EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/ConfigDescriptor.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/ConfigDescriptor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6a3a87a208 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/ConfigDescriptor.h @@ -0,0 +1,72 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ConfigDescriptor.c. + */ + +#ifndef _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ +#define _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "StillImageHost.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Pipe address of the Still Image data IN pipe. */ + #define SIMAGE_DATA_IN_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Pipe address of the Still Image data OUT pipe. */ + #define SIMAGE_DATA_OUT_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /** Pipe address of the Still Image events IN pipe. */ + #define SIMAGE_EVENTS_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_IN | 3) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref ProcessConfigurationDescriptor() function. */ + enum StillImageHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t + { + SuccessfulConfigRead = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully */ + ControlError = 1, /**< A control request to the device failed to complete successfully */ + DescriptorTooLarge = 2, /**< The device's Configuration Descriptor is too large to process */ + InvalidConfigDataReturned = 3, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor */ + NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 4, /**< A compatible interface with the required endpoints was not found */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void); + + uint8_t DComp_NextStillImageInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextStillImageInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/Lib/PIMACodes.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/Lib/PIMACodes.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7c3880b274 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/Lib/PIMACodes.h @@ -0,0 +1,45 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header containing macros for possible PIMA commands. Refer to the PIMA standard + * documentation for more information on each PIMA command. + */ + +#ifndef _PIMA_CODES_H_ + + /* Macros: */ + #define PIMA_OPERATION_GETDEVICEINFO 0x1001 + #define PIMA_OPERATION_OPENSESSION 0x1002 + #define PIMA_OPERATION_CLOSESESSION 0x1003 + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/Lib/StillImageCommands.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/Lib/StillImageCommands.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d233e27700 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/Lib/StillImageCommands.c @@ -0,0 +1,268 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Still Image Device commands, to issue PIMA commands to the device for + * reading device status, capacity, and other characteristics as well as + * reading and writing of stored image data. + */ + +#include "StillImageCommands.h" + +/** PIMA block container for the block to send to the device */ +PIMA_Container_t PIMA_SendBlock; + +/** PIMA block container for the last received block from the device */ +PIMA_Container_t PIMA_ReceivedBlock; + +/** PIMA block container for the last event block received from the device */ +PIMA_Container_t PIMA_EventBlock; + + +/** Function to send the PIMA command container to the attached still image device. */ +void SImage_SendBlockHeader(void) +{ + /* Unfreeze the data OUT pipe ready for data transmission */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(SIMAGE_DATA_OUT_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Write the PIMA block to the data OUT pipe */ + Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(&PIMA_SendBlock, PIMA_COMMAND_SIZE(0), NULL); + + /* If the block type is a command, send its parameters (if any) */ + if (PIMA_SendBlock.Type == PIMA_CONTAINER_CommandBlock) + { + /* Determine the size of the parameters in the block via the data length attribute */ + uint8_t ParamBytes = (PIMA_SendBlock.DataLength - PIMA_COMMAND_SIZE(0)); + + /* Check if any parameters in the command block */ + if (ParamBytes) + { + /* Write the PIMA parameters to the data OUT pipe */ + Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(&PIMA_SendBlock.Params, ParamBytes, NULL); + } + + /* Send the PIMA command block to the attached device */ + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + } + + /* Freeze pipe after use */ + Pipe_Freeze(); +} + +/** Function to receive a PIMA event container from the attached still image device. + * + * \return A value from the Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t SImage_ReceiveEventHeader(void) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Unfreeze the events pipe */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(SIMAGE_EVENTS_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Read in the event data into the global structure */ + ErrorCode = Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(&PIMA_EventBlock, sizeof(PIMA_EventBlock), NULL); + + /* Clear the pipe after read complete to prepare for next event */ + Pipe_ClearIN(); + + /* Freeze the event pipe again after use */ + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return ErrorCode; +} + +/** Function to receive a PIMA response container from the attached still image device. + * + * \return A value from the Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t SImage_ReceiveBlockHeader(void) +{ + uint16_t TimeoutMSRem = COMMAND_DATA_TIMEOUT_MS; + uint16_t PreviousFrameNumber = USB_Host_GetFrameNumber(); + + /* Unfreeze the data IN pipe */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(SIMAGE_DATA_IN_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Wait until data received on the IN pipe */ + while (!(Pipe_IsINReceived())) + { + uint16_t CurrentFrameNumber = USB_Host_GetFrameNumber(); + + /* Check to see if a new frame has been issued (1ms elapsed) */ + if (CurrentFrameNumber != PreviousFrameNumber) + { + /* Save the new frame number and decrement the timeout period */ + PreviousFrameNumber = CurrentFrameNumber; + TimeoutMSRem--; + + /* Check to see if the timeout period for the command has elapsed */ + if (!(TimeoutMSRem)) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_Timeout; + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + Pipe_SelectPipe(SIMAGE_DATA_OUT_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Check if pipe stalled (command failed by device) */ + if (Pipe_IsStalled()) + { + /* Clear the stall condition on the OUT pipe */ + USB_Host_ClearEndpointStall(Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress()); + + /* Return error code and break out of the loop */ + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_PipeStalled; + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + Pipe_SelectPipe(SIMAGE_DATA_IN_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Check if pipe stalled (command failed by device) */ + if (Pipe_IsStalled()) + { + /* Clear the stall condition on the IN pipe */ + USB_Host_ClearEndpointStall(Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress()); + + /* Return error code */ + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_PipeStalled; + } + + /* Check to see if the device was disconnected, if so exit function */ + if (USB_HostState == HOST_STATE_Unattached) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + } + + /* Load in the response from the attached device */ + Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(&PIMA_ReceivedBlock, PIMA_COMMAND_SIZE(0), NULL); + + /* Check if the returned block type is a response block */ + if (PIMA_ReceivedBlock.Type == PIMA_CONTAINER_ResponseBlock) + { + /* Determine the size of the parameters in the block via the data length attribute */ + uint8_t ParamBytes = (PIMA_ReceivedBlock.DataLength - PIMA_COMMAND_SIZE(0)); + + /* Check if the device has returned any parameters */ + if (ParamBytes) + { + /* Read the PIMA parameters from the data IN pipe */ + Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(&PIMA_ReceivedBlock.Params, ParamBytes, NULL); + } + + /* Clear pipe bank after use */ + Pipe_ClearIN(); + } + + /* Freeze the IN pipe after use */ + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +/** Function to send the given data to the device, after a command block has been issued. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Source data buffer to send to the device + * \param[in] Bytes Number of bytes to send + * + * \return A value from the Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t SImage_SendData(void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Bytes) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Unfreeze the data OUT pipe */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(SIMAGE_DATA_OUT_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Write the data contents to the pipe */ + ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(Buffer, Bytes, NULL); + + /* Send the last packet to the attached device */ + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + /* Freeze the pipe again after use */ + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return ErrorCode; +} + +/** Function to receive the given data from the device, after a response block has been received. + * + * \param[out] Buffer Destination data buffer to put read bytes from the device + * \param[in] Bytes Number of bytes to receive + * + * \return A value from the Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t SImage_ReadData(void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Bytes) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Unfreeze the data IN pipe */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(SIMAGE_DATA_IN_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Read in the data into the buffer */ + ErrorCode = Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(Buffer, Bytes, NULL); + + /* Freeze the pipe again after use */ + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return ErrorCode; +} + +/** Function to test if a PIMA event block is waiting to be read in from the attached device. + * + * \return True if an event is waiting to be read in from the device, \c false otherwise + */ +bool SImage_IsEventReceived(void) +{ + bool IsEventReceived = false; + + /* Unfreeze the Event pipe */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(SIMAGE_EVENTS_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* If the pipe contains data, an event has been received */ + if (Pipe_BytesInPipe()) + IsEventReceived = true; + + /* Freeze the pipe after use */ + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return IsEventReceived; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/Lib/StillImageCommands.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/Lib/StillImageCommands.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..15ef75dcfc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/Lib/StillImageCommands.h @@ -0,0 +1,65 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for StillImageCommands.c. + */ + +#ifndef _STILL_IMAGE_COMMANDS_H_ +#define _STILL_IMAGE_COMMANDS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "PIMACodes.h" + #include "../StillImageHost.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Timeout period between the issuing of a command to a device, and the reception of the first packet. */ + #define COMMAND_DATA_TIMEOUT_MS 10000 + + /* External Variables: */ + extern PIMA_Container_t PIMA_SendBlock; + extern PIMA_Container_t PIMA_ReceivedBlock; + extern PIMA_Container_t PIMA_EventBlock; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SImage_SendBlockHeader(void); + uint8_t SImage_ReceiveBlockHeader(void); + uint8_t SImage_ReceiveEventHeader(void); + uint8_t SImage_SendData(void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Bytes); + uint8_t SImage_ReadData(void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Bytes); + bool SImage_IsEventReceived(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9df9531bfc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,365 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the StillImageHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "StillImageHost.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "Still Image Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + StillImageHost_Task(); + + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Attached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Getting Config Data.\r\n")); + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Get and process the configuration descriptor data */ + if ((ErrorCode = ProcessConfigurationDescriptor()) != SuccessfulConfigRead) + { + if (ErrorCode == ControlError) + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Get Configuration).\r\n")); + else + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Invalid Device.\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* Set the device configuration to the first configuration (rarely do devices use multiple configurations) */ + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Set Configuration).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Still Image Device Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Task to print device information through the serial port, and open/close a test PIMA session with the + * attached Still Image device. + */ +void StillImageHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Indicate device busy via the status LEDs */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + + puts_P(PSTR("Retrieving Device Info...\r\n")); + + PIMA_SendBlock = (PIMA_Container_t) + { + .DataLength = PIMA_COMMAND_SIZE(0), + .Type = PIMA_CONTAINER_CommandBlock, + .Code = PIMA_OPERATION_GETDEVICEINFO, + .TransactionID = 0x00000000, + .Params = {}, + }; + + /* Send the GETDEVICEINFO block */ + SImage_SendBlockHeader(); + + /* Receive the response data block */ + if ((ErrorCode = SImage_ReceiveBlockHeader()) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + { + ShowCommandError(ErrorCode, false); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + /* Calculate the size of the returned device info data structure */ + uint16_t DeviceInfoSize = (PIMA_ReceivedBlock.DataLength - PIMA_COMMAND_SIZE(0)); + + /* Create a buffer large enough to hold the entire device info */ + uint8_t DeviceInfo[DeviceInfoSize]; + + /* Read in the data block data (containing device info) */ + SImage_ReadData(DeviceInfo, DeviceInfoSize); + + /* Once all the data has been read, the pipe must be cleared before the response can be sent */ + Pipe_ClearIN(); + + /* Create a pointer for walking through the info dataset */ + uint8_t* DeviceInfoPos = DeviceInfo; + + /* Skip over the data before the unicode device information strings */ + DeviceInfoPos += 8; // Skip to VendorExtensionDesc String + DeviceInfoPos += (1 + UNICODE_STRING_LENGTH(*DeviceInfoPos)); // Skip over VendorExtensionDesc String + DeviceInfoPos += 2; // Skip over FunctionalMode + DeviceInfoPos += (4 + (*(uint32_t*)DeviceInfoPos << 1)); // Skip over Supported Operations Array + DeviceInfoPos += (4 + (*(uint32_t*)DeviceInfoPos << 1)); // Skip over Supported Events Array + DeviceInfoPos += (4 + (*(uint32_t*)DeviceInfoPos << 1)); // Skip over Supported Device Properties Array + DeviceInfoPos += (4 + (*(uint32_t*)DeviceInfoPos << 1)); // Skip over Capture Formats Array + DeviceInfoPos += (4 + (*(uint32_t*)DeviceInfoPos << 1)); // Skip over Image Formats Array + + /* Extract and convert the Manufacturer Unicode string to ASCII and print it through the USART */ + char Manufacturer[*DeviceInfoPos]; + UnicodeToASCII(DeviceInfoPos, Manufacturer); + printf_P(PSTR(" Manufacturer: %s\r\n"), Manufacturer); + + DeviceInfoPos += 1 + UNICODE_STRING_LENGTH(*DeviceInfoPos); // Skip over Manufacturer String + + /* Extract and convert the Model Unicode string to ASCII and print it through the USART */ + char Model[*DeviceInfoPos]; + UnicodeToASCII(DeviceInfoPos, Model); + printf_P(PSTR(" Model: %s\r\n"), Model); + + DeviceInfoPos += 1 + UNICODE_STRING_LENGTH(*DeviceInfoPos); // Skip over Model String + + /* Extract and convert the Device Version Unicode string to ASCII and print it through the USART */ + char DeviceVersion[*DeviceInfoPos]; + UnicodeToASCII(DeviceInfoPos, DeviceVersion); + printf_P(PSTR(" Device Version: %s\r\n"), DeviceVersion); + + /* Receive the final response block from the device */ + if ((ErrorCode = SImage_ReceiveBlockHeader()) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + { + ShowCommandError(ErrorCode, false); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + /* Verify that the command completed successfully */ + if ((PIMA_ReceivedBlock.Type != PIMA_CONTAINER_ResponseBlock) || (PIMA_ReceivedBlock.Code != PIMA_RESPONSE_OK)) + { + ShowCommandError(PIMA_ReceivedBlock.Code, true); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Opening Session...\r\n")); + + PIMA_SendBlock = (PIMA_Container_t) + { + .DataLength = PIMA_COMMAND_SIZE(1), + .Type = PIMA_CONTAINER_CommandBlock, + .Code = PIMA_OPERATION_OPENSESSION, + .TransactionID = 0x00000000, + .Params = {0x00000001}, + }; + + /* Send the OPENSESSION block, open a session with an ID of 0x0001 */ + SImage_SendBlockHeader(); + + /* Receive the response block from the device */ + if ((ErrorCode = SImage_ReceiveBlockHeader()) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + { + ShowCommandError(ErrorCode, false); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + /* Verify that the command completed successfully */ + if ((PIMA_ReceivedBlock.Type != PIMA_CONTAINER_ResponseBlock) || (PIMA_ReceivedBlock.Code != PIMA_RESPONSE_OK)) + { + ShowCommandError(PIMA_ReceivedBlock.Code, true); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Closing Session...\r\n")); + + PIMA_SendBlock = (PIMA_Container_t) + { + .DataLength = PIMA_COMMAND_SIZE(1), + .Type = PIMA_CONTAINER_CommandBlock, + .Code = PIMA_OPERATION_CLOSESESSION, + .TransactionID = 0x00000001, + .Params = {0x00000001}, + }; + + /* Send the CLOSESESSION block, close the session with an ID of 0x0001 */ + SImage_SendBlockHeader(); + + /* Receive the response block from the device */ + if ((ErrorCode = SImage_ReceiveBlockHeader()) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + { + ShowCommandError(ErrorCode, false); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + /* Verify that the command completed successfully */ + if ((PIMA_ReceivedBlock.Type != PIMA_CONTAINER_ResponseBlock) || (PIMA_ReceivedBlock.Code != PIMA_RESPONSE_OK)) + { + ShowCommandError(PIMA_ReceivedBlock.Code, true); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("Done.\r\n")); + + /* Indicate device no longer busy */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); +} + +/** Function to convert a given Unicode encoded string to ASCII. This function will only work correctly on Unicode + * strings which contain ASCII printable characters only. + * + * \param[in] UnicodeString Pointer to a Unicode encoded input string + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to a buffer where the converted ASCII string should be stored + */ +void UnicodeToASCII(uint8_t* UnicodeString, + char* Buffer) +{ + /* Get the number of characters in the string, skip to the start of the string data */ + uint8_t CharactersRemaining = *(UnicodeString++); + + /* Loop through the entire unicode string */ + while (CharactersRemaining--) + { + /* Load in the next unicode character (only the lower byte, as only Unicode coded ASCII is supported) */ + *(Buffer++) = *UnicodeString; + + /* Jump to the next unicode character */ + UnicodeString += 2; + } + + /* Null terminate the string */ + *Buffer = 0; +} + +/** Displays a PIMA command error via the device's serial port. + * + * \param[in] ErrorCode Error code of the function which failed to complete successfully + * \param[in] ResponseCodeError Indicates if the error is due to a command failed indication from the device, or a communication failure + */ +void ShowCommandError(uint8_t ErrorCode, + bool ResponseCodeError) +{ + const char* FailureType = ((ResponseCodeError) ? PSTR("Response Code != OK") : PSTR("Transaction Fail")); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Command Error (%S).\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), FailureType, ErrorCode); + + /* Indicate error via status LEDs */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..43ad59c967 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,89 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for StillImageHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _STILL_IMAGE_HOST_H_ +#define _STILL_IMAGE_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + + #include "Lib/StillImageCommands.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void StillImageHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + + void UnicodeToASCII(uint8_t* UnicodeString, + char* Buffer); + void ShowCommandError(uint8_t ErrorCode, + bool ResponseCodeError); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..193228a207 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,65 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Still Image Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Still Image Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Still Image Class Specification \n + * PIMA 15740 Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Still Image host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference + * application for implementing a Still Image host, for USB devices such as + * digital cameras. + * + * This demo will enumerate an attached USB Still Image device, print out its + * information structure, open a session with the device and finally close the + * session. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cbf1e2ca2e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,54 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Still Image Host Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.si.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.si"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.si" caption="Still Image Host Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Still Image Host demo, implementing a Still Image host that can send and receive PIMA data to and from an attached device. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="Still Image Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="StillImageHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="StillImageHost.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="ConfigDescriptor.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="StillImageHost.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="ConfigDescriptor.h"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/StillImageCommands.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/StillImageCommands.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/PIMACodes.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7eca05a943 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Still Image Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dd7b4529a6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/StillImageHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = StillImageHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c ConfigDescriptor.c Lib/StillImageCommands.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/ConfigDescriptor.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/ConfigDescriptor.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fa5312ffe2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/ConfigDescriptor.c @@ -0,0 +1,234 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Configuration Descriptor processing routines, to determine the correct pipe configurations + * needed to communication with an attached USB device. Descriptors are special computer-readable structures + * which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + +/** Reads and processes an attached device's descriptors, to determine compatibility and pipe configurations. This + * routine will read in the entire configuration descriptor, and configure the hosts pipes to correctly communicate + * with compatible devices. + * + * This routine searches for a CDC interface descriptor containing bulk data IN and OUT endpoints, and an interrupt event endpoint. + * + * \return An error code from the \ref CDCHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t enum. + */ +uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void) +{ + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + void* CurrConfigLocation = ConfigDescriptorData; + uint16_t CurrConfigBytesRem; + + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* CDCControlInterface = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* NotificationEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Retrieve the entire configuration descriptor into the allocated buffer */ + switch (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &CurrConfigBytesRem, ConfigDescriptorData, sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData))) + { + case HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful: + break; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_InvalidData: + return InvalidConfigDataReturned; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_BuffOverflow: + return DescriptorTooLarge; + default: + return ControlError; + } + + while (!(DataINEndpoint) || !(DataOUTEndpoint) || !(NotificationEndpoint)) + { + /* See if we've found a likely compatible interface, and if there is an endpoint within that interface */ + if (!(CDCControlInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextCDCDataInterfaceEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Check if we have already found the control interface's notification endpoint or not */ + if (NotificationEndpoint) + { + /* Get the next CDC data interface from the configuration descriptor */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextCDCDataInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Clear any found endpoints */ + DataINEndpoint = NULL; + DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + } + else + { + /* Get the next CDC control interface from the configuration descriptor */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextCDCControlInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Save the interface in case we need to refer back to it later */ + CDCControlInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Clear any found endpoints */ + NotificationEndpoint = NULL; + } + + /* Skip the remainder of the loop as we have not found an endpoint yet */ + continue; + } + + /* Retrieve the endpoint address from the endpoint descriptor */ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* If the endpoint is a IN type endpoint */ + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + { + /* Check if the found endpoint is a interrupt or bulk type descriptor */ + if ((EndpointData->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK) == EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT) + NotificationEndpoint = EndpointData; + else + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + else + { + DataOUTEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + } + + /* Configure the CDC data IN pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(CDC_DATA_IN_PIPE, EP_TYPE_BULK, DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + + /* Configure the CDC data OUT pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(CDC_DATA_OUT_PIPE, EP_TYPE_BULK, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + + /* Configure the CDC notification pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(CDC_NOTIFICATION_PIPE, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, NotificationEndpoint->EndpointAddress, NotificationEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + Pipe_SetInterruptPeriod(NotificationEndpoint->PollingIntervalMS); + + /* Valid data found, return success */ + return SuccessfulConfigRead; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interface descriptor of the correct CDC control Class, Subclass and Protocol values. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextCDCControlInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Check the CDC descriptor class, subclass and protocol, break out if correct control interface found */ + if ((Interface->Class == CDC_CSCP_CDCClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interface descriptor of the correct CDC data Class, Subclass and Protocol values. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextCDCDataInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Check the CDC descriptor class, subclass and protocol, break out if correct data interface found */ + if ((Interface->Class == CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next bulk IN or OUT endpoint, or interrupt IN endpoint within the current interface, + * aborting the search if another interface descriptor is found before the required endpoint (so that it may be compared + * using a different comparator to determine if it is another CDC class interface). + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextCDCDataInterfaceEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* Endpoint = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + if (((Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK) == EP_TYPE_BULK) || + ((Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK) == EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/ConfigDescriptor.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/ConfigDescriptor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..303e59007e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/ConfigDescriptor.h @@ -0,0 +1,73 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ConfigDescriptor.c. + */ + +#ifndef _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ +#define _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "VirtualSerialHost.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Pipe address for the CDC data IN pipe. */ + #define CDC_DATA_IN_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Pipe address for the CDC data OUT pipe. */ + #define CDC_DATA_OUT_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /** Pipe address for the CDC notification IN pipe. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_IN | 3) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref ProcessConfigurationDescriptor() function. */ + enum CDCHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t + { + SuccessfulConfigRead = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully */ + ControlError = 1, /**< A control request to the device failed to complete successfully */ + DescriptorTooLarge = 2, /**< The device's Configuration Descriptor is too large to process */ + InvalidConfigDataReturned = 3, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor */ + NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 4, /**< A compatible interface with the required endpoints was not found */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void); + + uint8_t DComp_NextCDCControlInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextCDCDataInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextCDCDataInterfaceEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/VirtualSerialHost.c b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/VirtualSerialHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..832fdc20d1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/VirtualSerialHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,239 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the VirtualSerialHost demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "VirtualSerialHost.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "CDC Host Demo running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + CDCHost_Task(); + + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "Device Attached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_GREEN "\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Getting Config Data.\r\n")); + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + /* Get and process the configuration descriptor data */ + if ((ErrorCode = ProcessConfigurationDescriptor()) != SuccessfulConfigRead) + { + if (ErrorCode == ControlError) + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Get Configuration).\r\n")); + else + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Invalid Device.\r\n")); + + printf_P(PSTR(" -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* Set the device configuration to the first configuration (rarely do devices use multiple configurations) */ + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Set Configuration).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + CDC_LineEncoding_t LineEncoding = { .BaudRateBPS = 9600, + .CharFormat = CDC_LINEENCODING_OneStopBit, + .ParityType = CDC_PARITY_None, + .DataBits = 8 }; + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = CDC_REQ_SetLineEncoding, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = sizeof(LineEncoding), + }; + + /* Set the Line Encoding of the CDC interface within the device, so that it is ready to accept data */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + if (USB_Host_SendControlRequest(&LineEncoding) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Control Error (Set Line Encoding).\r\n" + " -- Error Code: %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("CDC Device Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Task to read in data received from the attached CDC device and print it to the serial port. + */ +void CDCHost_Task(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Select the data IN pipe */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(CDC_DATA_IN_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Check to see if a packet has been received */ + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + { + /* Re-freeze IN pipe after the packet has been received */ + Pipe_Freeze(); + + /* Check if data is in the pipe */ + if (Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed()) + { + /* Get the length of the pipe data, and create a new buffer to hold it */ + uint16_t BufferLength = Pipe_BytesInPipe(); + uint8_t Buffer[BufferLength]; + + /* Read in the pipe data to the temporary buffer */ + Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(Buffer, BufferLength, NULL); + + /* Print out the buffer contents to the USART */ + for (uint16_t BufferByte = 0; BufferByte < BufferLength; BufferByte++) + putchar(Buffer[BufferByte]); + } + + /* Clear the pipe after it is read, ready for the next packet */ + Pipe_ClearIN(); + } + + /* Re-freeze IN pipe after use */ + Pipe_Freeze(); + + /* Select and unfreeze the notification pipe */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(CDC_NOTIFICATION_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Check if a packet has been received */ + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + { + /* Discard the unused event notification */ + Pipe_ClearIN(); + } + + /* Freeze notification IN pipe after use */ + Pipe_Freeze(); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/VirtualSerialHost.h b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/VirtualSerialHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1c0c9b2808 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/VirtualSerialHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,80 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for VirtualSerialHost.c. + */ + +#ifndef _VIRTUALSERIAL_HOST_H_ +#define _VIRTUALSERIAL_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + #include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void CDCHost_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/VirtualSerialHost.txt b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/VirtualSerialHost.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1e1f9f1ae2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/VirtualSerialHost.txt @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage CDC Host Demo + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Abstract Control Model (ACM)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF CDC Class Standard</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * CDC host demonstration application. This gives a simple reference application + * for implementing a USB CDC host, for CDC devices using the standard ACM profile. + * + * This demo prints out received CDC data through the serial port. + * + * Note that this demo is only compatible with devices which report the correct CDC + * and ACM class, subclass and protocol values. Most USB-Serial cables have vendor + * specific features, thus use vendor-specific class/subclass/protocol codes to force + * the user to use specialized drivers. This demo is not compatible with such devices. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cb0d568d39 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Virtual Serial CDC Host Demo (Low Level APIs)" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.cdc.example.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.cdc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="none"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="16000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="16000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.demos.host.lowlevel.cdc" caption="Virtual Serial CDC Host Demo (Low Level APIs)">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Virtual Serial Host demo, implementing a CDC host that can send and receive data to and from an attached device. This demo uses the Low Level LUFA APIs to manually implement a USB Class for demonstration purposes without using the simpler in-built LUFA Class Driver APIs.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="CDC Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="VirtualSerialHost.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="VirtualSerialHost.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="ConfigDescriptor.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="VirtualSerialHost.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="ConfigDescriptor.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..df50a03e9e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Virtual Serial Host Demo" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0cb6c60636 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/VirtualSerialHost/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = VirtualSerialHost +SRC = $(TARGET).c ConfigDescriptor.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..90c1562194 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/LowLevel/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,46 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +# Makefile to build all the LUFA Host Demos. Call with "make all" to +# rebuild all Host demos. + +# Projects are pre-cleaned before each one is built, to ensure any +# custom LUFA library build options are reflected in the compiled +# code. + +PROJECT_DIRECTORIES := $(shell ls -d */) + +# This makefile is potentially infinitely recursive if something really bad +# happens when determining the set of project directories - hard-abort if +# more than 10 levels deep to avoid angry emails. +ifeq ($(MAKELEVEL), 10) + $(error EMERGENCY ABORT: INFINITE RECURSION DETECTED) +endif + +# Need to special-case building without a per-project object directory +ifeq ($(OBJDIR),) + # If no target specified, force "clean all" and disallow parallel build + ifeq ($(MAKECMDGOALS),) + MAKECMDGOALS := clean all + .NOTPARALLEL: + endif + + # If one of the targets is to build, force "clean" beforehand and disallow parallel build + ifneq ($(findstring all, $(MAKECMDGOALS)),) + MAKECMDGOALS := clean $(MAKECMDGOALS) + .NOTPARALLEL: + endif +endif + +%: $(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES) + @echo . > /dev/null + +$(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES): + @$(MAKE) -C $@ $(MAKECMDGOALS) + +.PHONY: $(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES) diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..abeb3f4a81 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/Host/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,21 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +# Makefile to build all the LUFA Class Driver and Low Level Demos. Call with +# "make all" to rebuild all demos of both types. + +# Projects are pre-cleaned before each one is built, to ensure any +# custom LUFA library build options are reflected in the compiled +# code. + +all: + +%: + $(MAKE) -C ClassDriver $@ + $(MAKE) -C LowLevel $@ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Demos/makefile b/lib/lufa/Demos/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..38694d9942 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Demos/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,22 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +# Makefile to build all the LUFA Demos. Call with "make all" to +# rebuild all demos. + +# Projects are pre-cleaned before each one is built, to ensure any +# custom LUFA library build options are reflected in the compiled +# code. + +all: + +%: + $(MAKE) -C Device $@ + $(MAKE) -C Host $@ + $(MAKE) -C DualRole $@ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/.gitignore b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/.gitignore new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..938768908a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/.gitignore @@ -0,0 +1,9 @@ +*.lss +*.bin +*.elf +*.hex +*.eep +*.map +*.o +*.d +*.sym diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/HID_EEPROM_Loader/HID_EEPROM_Loader.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/HID_EEPROM_Loader/HID_EEPROM_Loader.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..35ea2d79b7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/HID_EEPROM_Loader/HID_EEPROM_Loader.c @@ -0,0 +1,39 @@ +/* + DMBS Build System + Released into the public domain. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.fourwalledcubicle.com + */ + +/** \file + * + * Special application to extract an EEPROM image stored in FLASH memory, and + * copy it to the device EEPROM. This application is designed to be used with + * the HID build system module of DMBS to program the EEPROM of a target device + * that uses the HID bootloader protocol, which does not have native EEPROM + * programming support. + */ + +#include <avr/io.h> +#include <avr/eeprom.h> +#include <avr/pgmspace.h> + +/* References to the binary EEPROM data linked in the AVR's FLASH memory space */ +extern const char _binary_InputEEData_bin_start[]; +extern const char _binary_InputEEData_bin_end[]; +extern const char _binary_InputEEData_bin_size[]; + +/* Friendly names for the embedded binary data stored in FLASH memory space */ +#define InputEEData _binary_InputEEData_bin_start +#define InputEEData_size ((int)_binary_InputEEData_bin_size) + +int main(void) +{ + /* Copy out the embedded EEPROM data from FLASH to EEPROM memory space */ + for (uint16_t i = 0; i < InputEEData_size; i++) + eeprom_update_byte((uint8_t*)i, pgm_read_byte(&InputEEData[i])); + + /* Infinite loop once complete */ + for (;;); +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/HID_EEPROM_Loader/makefile b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/HID_EEPROM_Loader/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..879eda8cf2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/HID_EEPROM_Loader/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,35 @@ +# +# DMBS Build System +# Released into the public domain. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.fourwalledcubicle.com +# + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = atmega128 +ARCH = AVR8 +F_CPU = 1000000 +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = HID_EEPROM_Loader +SRC = $(TARGET).c +CC_FLAGS = +LD_FLAGS = +OBJECT_FILES = InputEEData.o + +# Default target +all: + +# Determine the AVR sub-architecture of the build main application object file +FIND_AVR_SUBARCH = avr$(shell avr-objdump -f $(TARGET).o | grep architecture | cut -d':' -f3 | cut -d',' -f1) + +# Create a linkable object file with the input binary EEPROM data stored in the FLASH section +InputEEData.o: InputEEData.bin $(TARGET).o $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_OBJCPY_CMD) Converting \"$<\" to a object file \"$@\" + avr-objcopy -I binary -O elf32-avr -B $(call FIND_AVR_SUBARCH) --rename-section .data=.progmem.data,contents,alloc,readonly,data $< $@ + +# Include LUFA build script makefiles +include ../core.mk +include ../gcc.mk +include ../hid.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/License.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/License.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..322c7624e5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/License.txt @@ -0,0 +1,32 @@ + DMBS Build System + Released into the public domain. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.fourwalledcubicle.com + + + +This is free and unencumbered software released into the public domain. + +Anyone is free to copy, modify, publish, use, compile, sell, or +distribute this software, either in source code form or as a compiled +binary, for any purpose, commercial or non-commercial, and by any +means. + +In jurisdictions that recognize copyright laws, the author or authors +of this software dedicate any and all copyright interest in the +software to the public domain. We make this dedication for the benefit +of the public at large and to the detriment of our heirs and +successors. We intend this dedication to be an overt act of +relinquishment in perpetuity of all present and future rights to this +software under copyright law. + +THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, +EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF +MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. +IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR +OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, +ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR +OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. + +For more information, please refer to <http://unlicense.org/> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/ModulesOverview.md b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/ModulesOverview.md new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1fd9cc11cc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/ModulesOverview.md @@ -0,0 +1,38 @@ +DMBS - Dean's Makefile Build System +=================================== + + +Modules Overview +---------------- + +The following modules are currently included: + + - [ATPROGRAM](atprogram.md) - Device Programming + - [AVRDUDE](avrdude.md) - Device Programming + - [CORE](core.md) - DMBS Core Functionality + - [CPPCHECK](cppcheck.md) - Static Code Analysis + - [DFU](dfu.md) - Device Programming + - [DOXYGEN](doxygen.md) - Automated Source Code Documentation + - [GCC](gcc.md) - Compiling/Assembling/Linking with GCC + - [HID](hid.md) - Device Programming + +## Importing modules into your project makefile + +To use a module, it is recommended to add the following boilerplate to your +makefile: + + # Include DMBS build script makefiles + DMBS_PATH ?= ../DMBS + +Which can then used to indicate the location of your DMBS installation, relative +to the current directory, when importing modules. For example: + + DMBS_PATH ?= ../DMBS + include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk + include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk + +Imports the `CORE` and `GCC` modules from DMBS using a single path relative to +your project's makefile. + +If you wish to write your own DMBS module(s), +[see the documentation here for more details.](WritingYourOwnModules.md) diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/WritingYourOwnModules.md b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/WritingYourOwnModules.md new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..16df7a53bb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/WritingYourOwnModules.md @@ -0,0 +1,95 @@ +DMBS - Dean's Makefile Build System +=================================== + + +Writing Your Own Modules +------------------------ + +A DMBS module consists of the several boilerplate sections, explained below. + +## The DMBS module hooks + +Your module needs to advertise to DMBS its name, its makefile targets, the +required and optional variables, and the variables and macros the module +provides for use elsewhere. This is achieved with the following section: + + DMBS_BUILD_MODULES += EXAMPLE + DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS += example-target another-target + DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS += MANDATORY_NAME ALSO_MANDATORY + DMBS_BUILD_OPTIONAL_VARS += OPTIONAL_NAME ALSO_OPTIONAL + DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_VARS += MEANING_OF_LIFE + DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_MACROS += STRIP_WHITESPACE + +The example above declares that this module is called `EXAMPLE`, and exposes the +listed targets, variable requirements and provides variables and macros. + +Your module name and provided variable/macro names must be unique, however you +can (and should) re-use variable names where appropriate if they apply to +several modules (such as `ARCH` to specify the project's microcontroller +architecture). Re-using targets is not recommended, but can be used to extend +the dependencies of another module's targets. + +## Importing the CORE module + +Next, your module should always import the DMBS `CORE` module, via the +following: + + # Conditionally import the CORE module of DMBS if it is not already imported + DMBS_MODULE_PATH := $(patsubst %/,%,$(dir $(lastword $(MAKEFILE_LIST)))) + ifeq ($(findstring CORE, $(DMBS_BUILD_MODULES)),) + include $(DMBS_MODULE_PATH)/core.mk + endif + +This ensures that the `make help` target is always available. In addition, the +`CORE` module exposes some [commonly used macros and variables](core.md) to +your module. + +## Setting optional variable's defaults + +If a variable is optional, you should provide a default value. Do this via the +`?=` operator of `make`, which sets a variable's value if it has not yet been +set: + + MY_OPTIONAL_VARIABLE ?= some_default_value + +## Sanity checking user input + +Sanity checks are what make DMBS useful. Where possible, validate user input and +convert generated errors to human-friendly messages. This can be achieved by +enforcing that all the declared module mandatory variables have been set by the +user: + + # Sanity-check values of mandatory user-supplied variables + $(foreach MANDATORY_VAR, $(DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS), $(call ERROR_IF_UNSET, $(MANDATORY_VAR))) + +As well as complaining if they are set, but currently empty: + + $(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, SOME_MANDATORY_VARIABLE) + $(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, SOME_OPTIONAL_BUT_NON_EMPTY_VARIABLE) + +Or even if they are boolean (`Y` or `N`) variables that have an invalid value: + + $(call ERROR_IF_NONBOOL, SOME_BOOL_VARIABLE) + +## Adding targets + +The meat of a DMBS module is the targets, which are run when the user types +`make {target name}` from the command line. These can be as complex or simple +as you like. See the GNU make manual for information on writing make targets. + + example-target: + echo "Your DMBS module works!" + +## And finally, list the PHONYs + +Important in GNU Make is the concept of phony targets; this special directive +tells make that a given target should never be considered a valid file. Listing +phonies ensures that, for example, if your module had a target called `build`, +it would always run when the user types `make build` from the command line, even +if a file called `build` existed in the user project folder. + +You can list module-internal targets here, as well as mark all public targets +via the module header's `DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS` variable. + + # Phony build targets for this module + .PHONY: $(DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS) some-module-internal-target another-internal-target diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/atprogram.md b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/atprogram.md new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ea1b0d9194 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/atprogram.md @@ -0,0 +1,119 @@ +DMBS - Dean's Makefile Build System +=================================== + + +Module: ATPROGRAM +----------------- + +The ATPROGRAM module provides build targets for use with the official +`ATPROGRAM` back-end utility distributed with the free +[Atmel Studio](http://www.atmel.com) software released by Atmel. + +## Importing This Module into a Makefile: + +To use this module in your application makefile, add the following code to your +makefile: + + include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk + +## Prerequisites: + +This module requires the `atprogram.exe` utility to be available in your +system's `PATH` variable. The `atprogram.exe` utility is distributed in Atmel +Studio (usually) inside the application install folder's `atbackend` +subdirectory. + +## Build Targets: + +The following targets are supported by this module: + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>atprogram</td> + <td>Program the device FLASH memory with the application's executable data.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>atprogram-ee</td> + <td>Program the device EEPROM memory with the application's EEPROM data.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Mandatory Variables: + +The following variables must be defined (with a `NAME = VALUE` syntax, one +variable per line) in the user makefile to be able to use this module: + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>MCU</td> + <td>Name of the Atmel processor model (e.g. `at90usb1287`).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>TARGET</td> + <td>Name of the application output file prefix (e.g. `TestApplication`).</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Optional Variables: + +The following variables may be defined (with a `NAME = VALUE` syntax, one +variable per line) in the user makefile. If not specified, a default value will +be assumed. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>ATPROGRAM_PROGRAMMER</td> + <td>Name of the Atmel programmer or debugger tool to communicate with (e.g. `jtagice3`). Default is `atmelice`.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>ATPROGRAM_INTERFACE</td> + <td>Name of the programming interface to use when programming the target (e.g. `spi`). Default is `jtag`.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>ATPROGRAM_PORT</td> + <td>Name of the communication port to use when when programming with a serially connected tool (e.g. `COM2`). Default is `usb`.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Provided Variables: + +The following variables may be referenced in a user makefile (via `$(NAME)` +syntax) if desired, as they are provided by this module. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>N/A</td> + <td>This module provides no variables.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Provided Macros: + +The following macros may be referenced in a user makefile (via +`$(call NAME, ARG1, ARG2, ...)` syntax) if desired, as they are provided by +this module. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>N/A</td> + <td>This module provides no macros.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Module Changelog: + +The changes to this module since its initial release are listed below, as of the +DMBS version where the change was made. + +### 20160403 +Initial release. diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/atprogram.mk b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/atprogram.mk new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a505275aed --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/atprogram.mk @@ -0,0 +1,68 @@ +# +# DMBS Build System +# Released into the public domain. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.fourwalledcubicle.com +# + +DMBS_BUILD_MODULES += ATPROGRAM +DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS += atprogram atprogram-ee +DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS += MCU TARGET +DMBS_BUILD_OPTIONAL_VARS += ATPROGRAM_PROGRAMMER ATPROGRAM_INTERFACE ATPROGRAM_PORT +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_VARS += +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_MACROS += + +# Conditionally import the CORE module of DMBS if it is not already imported +DMBS_MODULE_PATH := $(patsubst %/,%,$(dir $(lastword $(MAKEFILE_LIST)))) +ifeq ($(findstring CORE, $(DMBS_BUILD_MODULES)),) + include $(DMBS_MODULE_PATH)/core.mk +endif + +# Default values of optionally user-supplied variables +ATPROGRAM_PROGRAMMER ?= atmelice +ATPROGRAM_INTERFACE ?= jtag +ATPROGRAM_PORT ?= + +# Sanity check user supplied values +$(foreach MANDATORY_VAR, $(DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS), $(call ERROR_IF_UNSET, $(MANDATORY_VAR))) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, MCU) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, TARGET) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, ATPROGRAM_PROGRAMMER) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, ATPROGRAM_INTERFACE) + +# Output Messages +MSG_ATPROGRAM_CMD := ' [ATPRGRM] :' + +# Construct base atprogram command flags +BASE_ATPROGRAM_FLAGS := --tool $(ATPROGRAM_PROGRAMMER) --interface $(ATPROGRAM_INTERFACE) --device $(MCU) +ifneq ($(ATPROGRAM_PORT),) + BASE_ATPROGRAM_FLAGS += --port $(ATPROGRAM_PORT) +endif + +# Construct the flags to use for the various memory spaces +ifeq ($(ARCH), AVR8) + ATPROGRAM_FLASH_FLAGS := --chiperase --flash + ATPROGRAM_EEPROM_FLAGS := --eeprom +else ifeq ($(ARCH), XMEGA) + ATPROGRAM_FLASH_FLAGS := --erase --flash + ATPROGRAM_EEPROM_FLAGS := --eeprom +else ifeq ($(ARCH), UC3) + ATPROGRAM_FLASH_FLAGS := --erase + ATPROGRAM_EEPROM_FLAGS := --eeprom +else + $(error Unsupported architecture "$(ARCH)") +endif + +# Programs in the target FLASH memory using ATPROGRAM +atprogram: $(TARGET).elf $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_ATPROGRAM_CMD) Programming device \"$(MCU)\" FLASH using \"$(ATPROGRAM_PROGRAMMER)\" + atprogram $(BASE_ATPROGRAM_FLAGS) program $(ATPROGRAM_FLASH_FLAGS) --file $< + +# Programs in the target EEPROM memory using ATPROGRAM +atprogram-ee: $(TARGET).elf $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_ATPROGRAM_CMD) Programming device \"$(MCU)\" EEPROM using \"$(ATPROGRAM_PROGRAMMER)\" + atprogram $(BASE_ATPROGRAM_FLAGS) program $(ATPROGRAM_EEPROM_FLAGS) --file $< + +# Phony build targets for this module +.PHONY: $(DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS) diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/avrdude.md b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/avrdude.md new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d6c71ce6db --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/avrdude.md @@ -0,0 +1,124 @@ +DMBS - Dean's Makefile Build System +=================================== + + +Module: AVRDUDE +----------------- + +The AVRDUDE module provides build targets for use with the official +open source `AVRDUDE` programmer utility, for the reprogramming of Atmel devices +using a wide variety of official and non-official programming devices and +bootloaders. + +## Importing This Module into a Makefile: + +To use this module in your application makefile, add the following code to your +makefile: + + include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk + +## Prerequisites: + +This module requires the `avrdude` utility to be available in your +system's `PATH` variable. The `avrdude` utility is distributed on the project's +[official site](https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/avrdude) but is also +made available in many *nix operating system's package managers. + +## Build Targets: + +The following targets are supported by this module: + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>avrdude</td> + <td>Program the device FLASH memory with the application's executable data.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>avrdude-ee</td> + <td>Program the device EEPROM memory with the application's EEPROM data.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Mandatory Variables: + +The following variables must be defined (with a `NAME = VALUE` syntax, one +variable per line) in the user makefile to be able to use this module: + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>MCU</td> + <td>Name of the Atmel processor model (e.g. `at90usb1287`).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>TARGET</td> + <td>Name of the application output file prefix (e.g. `TestApplication`).</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Optional Variables: + +The following variables may be defined (with a `NAME = VALUE` syntax, one +variable per line) in the user makefile. If not specified, a default value will +be assumed. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER</td> + <td>Name of the programmer/debugger tool or bootloader to communicate with (e.g. `jtagicemkii`). Default is `jtagicemkii`.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>AVRDUDE_PORT</td> + <td>Name of the communication port to use when when programming with a serially connected tool (e.g. `COM2`). Default is `usb`.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>AVRDUDE_FLAGS</td> + <td>Additional flags to pass to `avrdude` when invoking the tool. Default is empty (no additional flags).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>AVRDUDE_MEMORY</td> + <td>Memory space to program when executing the `avrdude` target (e.g. 'application` for an XMEGA device). Default is `flash`.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Provided Variables: + +The following variables may be referenced in a user makefile (via `$(NAME)` +syntax) if desired, as they are provided by this module. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>N/A</td> + <td>This module provides no variables.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Provided Macros: + +The following macros may be referenced in a user makefile (via +`$(call NAME, ARG1, ARG2, ...)` syntax) if desired, as they are provided by +this module. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>N/A</td> + <td>This module provides no macros.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Module Changelog: + +The changes to this module since its initial release are listed below, as of the +DMBS version where the change was made. + +### 20160403 +Initial release. diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/avrdude.mk b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/avrdude.mk new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c4bac8fd0e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/avrdude.mk @@ -0,0 +1,52 @@ +# +# DMBS Build System +# Released into the public domain. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.fourwalledcubicle.com +# + +DMBS_BUILD_MODULES += AVRDUDE +DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS += avrdude avrdude-ee +DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS += MCU TARGET +DMBS_BUILD_OPTIONAL_VARS += AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER AVRDUDE_PORT AVRDUDE_FLAGS AVRDUDE_MEMORY +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_VARS += +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_MACROS += + +# Conditionally import the CORE module of DMBS if it is not already imported +DMBS_MODULE_PATH := $(patsubst %/,%,$(dir $(lastword $(MAKEFILE_LIST)))) +ifeq ($(findstring CORE, $(DMBS_BUILD_MODULES)),) + include $(DMBS_MODULE_PATH)/core.mk +endif + +# Default values of optionally user-supplied variables +AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER ?= jtagicemkii +AVRDUDE_PORT ?= usb +AVRDUDE_FLAGS ?= +AVRDUDE_MEMORY ?= flash + +# Sanity check user supplied values +$(foreach MANDATORY_VAR, $(DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS), $(call ERROR_IF_UNSET, $(MANDATORY_VAR))) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, MCU) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, TARGET) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, AVRDUDE_PORT) + +# Output Messages +MSG_AVRDUDE_CMD := ' [AVRDUDE] :' + +# Construct base avrdude command flags +BASE_AVRDUDE_FLAGS := -p $(MCU) -P $(AVRDUDE_PORT) -c $(AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER) + +# Programs in the target FLASH memory using AVRDUDE +avrdude: $(TARGET).hex $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_AVRDUDE_CMD) Programming device \"$(MCU)\" FLASH using \"$(AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER)\" on port \"$(AVRDUDE_PORT)\" + avrdude $(BASE_AVRDUDE_FLAGS) -U $(AVRDUDE_MEMORY):w:$< $(AVRDUDE_FLAGS) + +# Programs in the target EEPROM memory using AVRDUDE +avrdude-ee: $(TARGET).eep $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_AVRDUDE_CMD) Programming device \"$(MCU)\" EEPROM using \"$(AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER)\" on port \"$(AVRDUDE_PORT)\" + avrdude $(BASE_AVRDUDE_FLAGS) -U eeprom:w:$< $(AVRDUDE_FLAGS) + +# Phony build targets for this module +.PHONY: $(DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS) diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/core.md b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/core.md new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..406abfecd7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/core.md @@ -0,0 +1,136 @@ +DMBS - Dean's Makefile Build System +=================================== + + +Module: CORE +------------ + +The CORE module provides the core DMBS infrastructure used by other DMBS +modules, and must always be imported. Additionally, this module provides the +help system for DMBS. + +## Importing This Module into a Makefile: + +To use this module in your application makefile, add the following code to your +makefile: + + include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk + +## Prerequisites: + +None. + +## Build Targets: + +The following targets are supported by this module: + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>help</td> + <td>Show help for the current project, including a list of all available targets, variables and macros from the imported modules.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>list_targets</td> + <td>Show a list of all build targets from the imported modules.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>list_modules</td> + <td>Show a list of all imported modules.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>list_mandatory</td> + <td>Show a list of all mandatory variables from the imported modules.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>list_optional</td> + <td>Show a list of all optional variables from the imported modules.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>list_provided</td> + <td>Show a list of all variables provided by the imported modules.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>list_macros</td> + <td>Show a list of all macros provided by the imported modules.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Mandatory Variables: + +The following variables must be defined (with a `NAME = VALUE` syntax, one +variable per line) in the user makefile to be able to use this module: + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>N/A</td> + <td>This module has no mandatory variables.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Optional Variables: + +The following variables may be defined (with a `NAME = VALUE` syntax, one +variable per line) in the user makefile. If not specified, a default value will +be assumed. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>N/A</td> + <td>This module has no optional variables.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Provided Variables: + +The following variables may be referenced in a user makefile (via `$(NAME)` +syntax) if desired, as they are provided by this module. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>DMBS_VERSION</td> + <td>Current version of this DMBS release, as a ISO 8601 integer (such as `20160403` for `2016-04-03`).</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Provided Macros: + +The following macros may be referenced in a user makefile (via +`$(call NAME, ARG1, ARG2, ...)` syntax) if desired, as they are provided by +this module. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>DMBS_CHECK_VERSION</td> + <td>Macro to check the current DMBS version against the first argument and abort if the required version is newer than the current version.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>ERROR_IF_UNSET</td> + <td>Macro to check the given makefile variable name passed as the first argument, and abort if it has not been set by any makefile module.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>ERROR_IF_EMPTY</td> + <td>Macro to check the given makefile variable name passed as the first argument, and abort if it has an empty value.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>ERROR_IF_NONBOOL</td> + <td>Macro to check the given makefile variable name passed as the first argument, and abort if it has a value other than `Y` or `N`.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Module Changelog: + +The changes to this module since its initial release are listed below, as of the +DMBS version where the change was made. + +### 20160403 +Initial release. diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/core.mk b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/core.mk new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1edbd178c1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/core.mk @@ -0,0 +1,147 @@ +# +# DMBS Build System +# Released into the public domain. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.fourwalledcubicle.com +# + +DMBS_BUILD_MODULES += CORE +DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS += help list_targets list_modules list_mandatory list_optional list_provided list_macros +DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS += +DMBS_BUILD_OPTIONAL_VARS += +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_VARS += DMBS_VERSION +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_MACROS += DMBS_CHECK_VERSION ERROR_IF_UNSET ERROR_IF_EMPTY ERROR_IF_NONBOOL + +SHELL = /bin/sh + +# Current DMBS release version +DMBS_VERSION := 20170426 + +# Macro to check the DMBS version, aborts if the given DMBS version is below the current version +DMBS_CHECK_VERSION ?= $(if $(filter-out 0, $(shell test $(DMBS_VERSION) -lt $(1); echo $$?)), , $(error DMBS version $(1) or newer required, current version is $(DMBS_VERSION))) + +# Macros to use in other modules to check various conditions +ERROR_IF_UNSET ?= $(if $(filter undefined, $(origin $(strip $(1)))), $(error Makefile $(strip $(1)) value not set)) +ERROR_IF_EMPTY ?= $(if $(strip $($(strip $(1)))), , $(error Makefile $(strip $(1)) option cannot be blank)) +ERROR_IF_NONBOOL ?= $(if $(filter Y N, $($(strip $(1)))), , $(error Makefile $(strip $(1)) option must be Y or N)) + +# Converts a given input to a printable output using "(None)" if no items are in the list +CONVERT_TO_PRINTABLE = $(if $(strip $(1)), $(1), (None)) + +# Build sorted and filtered lists of the included build module data +SORTED_DMBS_BUILD_MODULES = $(sort $(DMBS_BUILD_MODULES)) +SORTED_DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS = $(sort $(DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS)) +SORTED_DMBS_MANDATORY_VARS = $(sort $(DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS)) +SORTED_DMBS_OPTIONAL_VARS = $(filter-out $(SORTED_DMBS_MANDATORY_VARS), $(sort $(DMBS_BUILD_OPTIONAL_VARS))) +SORTED_DMBS_PROVIDED_VARS = $(sort $(DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_VARS)) +SORTED_DMBS_PROVIDED_MACROS = $(sort $(DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_MACROS)) + +# Create printable versions of the sorted build module data (use "(None)" when no data is available) +PRINTABLE_DMBS_BUILD_MODULES = $(call CONVERT_TO_PRINTABLE, $(SORTED_DMBS_BUILD_MODULES)) +PRINTABLE_DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS = $(call CONVERT_TO_PRINTABLE, $(SORTED_DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS)) +PRINTABLE_DMBS_MANDATORY_VARS = $(call CONVERT_TO_PRINTABLE, $(SORTED_DMBS_MANDATORY_VARS)) +PRINTABLE_DMBS_OPTIONAL_VARS = $(call CONVERT_TO_PRINTABLE, $(SORTED_DMBS_OPTIONAL_VARS)) +PRINTABLE_DMBS_PROVIDED_VARS = $(call CONVERT_TO_PRINTABLE, $(SORTED_DMBS_PROVIDED_VARS)) +PRINTABLE_DMBS_PROVIDED_MACROS = $(call CONVERT_TO_PRINTABLE, $(SORTED_DMBS_PROVIDED_MACROS)) + +help: + @echo "===================================================================" + @echo " The DMBS Build System " + @echo " By Dean Camera { dean @ fourwalledcubicle . com } " + @echo "===================================================================" + @echo "DESCRIPTION: " + @echo " This build system is a set of makefile modules for (GNU) Make, to " + @echo " provide a simple system for building DMBS powered applications. " + @echo " Each makefile module can be included from within a user makefile, " + @echo " to expose the build rules documented in the comments at the top of" + @echo " each build module. " + @echo " " + @echo "USAGE: " + @echo " To execute a rule, define all variables indicated in the desired " + @echo " module as a required parameter before including the build module " + @echo " in your project makefile. Parameters marked as optional will " + @echo " assume a default value in the modules if not user-assigned. " + @echo " " + @echo " By default the target output shows both a friendly summary, as " + @echo " well as the actual invoked command. To suppress the output of the " + @echo " invoked commands and show only the friendly command output, run " + @echo " make with the \"-s\" switch added before the target(s). " + @echo "===================================================================" + @echo " " + @echo " Currently used build system modules in this application: " + @echo " " + @printf " %b" "$(PRINTABLE_DMBS_BUILD_MODULES:%= - %\n)" + @echo " " + @echo " " + @echo " Currently available build targets in this application: " + @echo " " + @printf " %b" "$(PRINTABLE_DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS:%= - %\n)" + @echo " " + @echo " " + @echo " Mandatory variables required by the selected build Modules: " + @echo " " + @printf " %b" "$(PRINTABLE_DMBS_MANDATORY_VARS:%= - %\n)" + @echo " " + @echo " " + @echo " Optional variables required by the selected build Modules: " + @echo " " + @printf " %b" "$(PRINTABLE_DMBS_OPTIONAL_VARS:%= - %\n)" + @echo " " + @echo " " + @echo " Variables provided by the selected build Modules: " + @echo " " + @printf " %b" "$(PRINTABLE_DMBS_PROVIDED_VARS:%= - %\n)" + @echo " " + @echo " " + @echo " Macros provided by the selected build Modules: " + @echo " " + @printf " %b" "$(PRINTABLE_DMBS_PROVIDED_MACROS:%= - %\n)" + @echo " " + @echo "===================================================================" + @echo " The DMBS Build System $(DMBS_VERSION) - Making MAKE easier." + @echo "===================================================================" + +# Lists build modules included by the project makefile, in alphabetical order +list_modules: + @echo Currently Used Build System Modules: + @printf " %b" "$(PRINTABLE_DMBS_BUILD_MODULES:%= - %\n)" + +# Lists build targets included by the project makefile, in alphabetical order +list_targets: + @echo Currently Available Build Targets: + @printf " %b" "$(PRINTABLE_DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS:%= - %\n)" + +# Lists mandatory variables that must be set by the project makefile, in alphabetical order +list_mandatory: + @echo Mandatory Variables for Included Modules: + @printf " %b" "$(PRINTABLE_DMBS_MANDATORY_VARS:%= - %\n)" + +# Lists optional variables that must be set by the project makefile, in alphabetical order +list_optional: + @echo Optional Variables for Included Modules: + @printf " %b" "$(PRINTABLE_DMBS_OPTIONAL_VARS:%= - %\n)" + +# Lists variables provided by the included build modules, in alphabetical order +list_provided: + @echo Variables Provided by the Included Modules: + @printf " %b" "$(PRINTABLE_DMBS_PROVIDED_VARS:%= - %\n)" + +# Lists macros provided by the included build modules, in alphabetical order +list_macros: + @echo Macros Provided by the Included Modules: + @printf " %b" "$(PRINTABLE_DMBS_PROVIDED_MACROS:%= - %\n)" + +# Debugging; "make print-VARNAME" will output the variable VARNAME's value +print-%: + @printf "%s = %s" $(@:print-%=%) $($(@:print-%=%)) + +# Disable default in-built make rules (those that are needed are explicitly +# defined, and doing so has performance benefits when recursively building) +ifeq ($(filter -r,$(MAKEFLAGS)),) + MAKEFLAGS += -r +endif +.SUFFIXES: + +# Phony build targets for this module +.PHONY: $(DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS) diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/cppcheck.md b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/cppcheck.md new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ec0e38d020 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/cppcheck.md @@ -0,0 +1,134 @@ +DMBS - Dean's Makefile Build System +=================================== + + +Module: CPPCHECK +----------------- + +The CPPCHECK module provides build targets to perform static analysis of the +user application, using the open source `cppcheck` tool. + +## Importing This Module into a Makefile: + +To use this module in your application makefile, add the following code to your +makefile: + + include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk + +## Prerequisites: + +This module requires the `cppcheck` utility to be available in your system's +`PATH` variable. The `cppcheck` utility is distributed on the project's +[official site](http://cppcheck.sourceforge.net/) but is also +made available in many *nix operating system's package managers. + +## Build Targets: + +The following targets are supported by this module: + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>cppcheck</td> + <td>Scan the project with CPPCHECK, and show all discovered issues.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>cppcheck-config</td> + <td>Check the project with CPPCHECK, to find missing header paths.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Mandatory Variables: + +The following variables must be defined (with a `NAME = VALUE` syntax, one +variable per line) in the user makefile to be able to use this module: + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>SRC</td> + <td>List of all project source files to scan.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Optional Variables: + +The following variables may be defined (with a `NAME = VALUE` syntax, one +variable per line) in the user makefile. If not specified, a default value will +be assumed. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>CPPCHECK_INCLUDES</td> + <td>Extra include paths to search, for any missing header files. Default is empty (no additional paths).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>CPPCHECK_EXCLUDES</td> + <td>List of source files, file paths or path fragments to exclude from the scan. Default is empty (no exclusions).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>CPPCHECK_MSG_TEMPLATE</td> + <td>Template for error and warning message output. Default is `{file}:{line}: {severity} ({id}): {message}`.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>CPPCHECK_ENABLE</td> + <td>List of CPPCHECK checks to enable. Default is `all`.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>CPPCHECK_SUPPRESS</td> + <td>List of CPPCHECK checks to ignore. Default is `variableScope missingInclude`.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>CPPCHECK_FAIL_ON_WARNING</td> + <td>Boolean, if `Y` the build will fail if CPPCHECK discovers any errors or warnings. If `N`, fail only on errors. Default is `Y`.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>CPPCHECK_QUIET</td> + <td>Boolean, if `Y` CPPCHECK will suppress all output except for discovered errors or warnings. If `N`, scan progress will be emitted. Default is `Y`.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>CPPCHECK_FLAGS_</td> + <td>Additional flags to pass to CPPCHECK when scans are started. Default is empty (no additional flags).</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Provided Variables: + +The following variables may be referenced in a user makefile (via `$(NAME)` +syntax) if desired, as they are provided by this module. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>N/A</td> + <td>This module provides no variables.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Provided Macros: + +The following macros may be referenced in a user makefile (via +`$(call NAME, ARG1, ARG2, ...)` syntax) if desired, as they are provided by +this module. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>N/A</td> + <td>This module provides no macros.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Module Changelog: + +The changes to this module since its initial release are listed below, as of the +DMBS version where the change was made. + +### 20160403 +Initial release. diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/cppcheck.mk b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/cppcheck.mk new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9b82fc3b08 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/cppcheck.mk @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +# +# DMBS Build System +# Released into the public domain. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.fourwalledcubicle.com +# + +DMBS_BUILD_MODULES += CPPCHECK +DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS += cppcheck cppcheck-config +DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS += SRC +DMBS_BUILD_OPTIONAL_VARS += CPPCHECK_INCLUDES CPPCHECK_EXCLUDES CPPCHECK_MSG_TEMPLATE CPPCHECK_ENABLE \ + CPPCHECK_SUPPRESS CPPCHECK_FAIL_ON_WARNING CPPCHECK_QUIET CPPCHECK_FLAGS +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_VARS += +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_MACROS += + +# Conditionally import the CORE module of DMBS if it is not already imported +DMBS_MODULE_PATH := $(patsubst %/,%,$(dir $(lastword $(MAKEFILE_LIST)))) +ifeq ($(findstring CORE, $(DMBS_BUILD_MODULES)),) + include $(DMBS_MODULE_PATH)/core.mk +endif + +# Default values of optionally user-supplied variables +CPPCHECK_INCLUDES ?= +CPPCHECK_EXCLUDES ?= +CPPCHECK_MSG_TEMPLATE ?= {file}:{line}: {severity} ({id}): {message} +CPPCHECK_ENABLE ?= all +CPPCHECK_SUPPRESS ?= variableScope missingInclude +CPPCHECK_FAIL_ON_WARNING ?= Y +CPPCHECK_QUIET ?= Y +CPPCHECK_FLAGS ?= + +# Sanity check user supplied values +$(foreach MANDATORY_VAR, $(DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS), $(call ERROR_IF_UNSET, $(MANDATORY_VAR))) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, SRC) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, CPPCHECK_MSG_TEMPLATE) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, CPPCHECK_ENABLE) +$(call ERROR_IF_NONBOOL, CPPCHECK_FAIL_ON_WARNING) +$(call ERROR_IF_NONBOOL, CPPCHECK_QUIET) + +# Build a default argument list for cppcheck +BASE_CPPCHECK_FLAGS := --template="$(CPPCHECK_MSG_TEMPLATE)" $(CPPCHECK_INCLUDES:%=-I%) $(CPPCHECK_EXCLUDES:%=-i%) --inline-suppr --force --std=c99 + +# Sanity check parameters and construct additional command line arguments to cppcheck +ifeq ($(CPPCHECK_FAIL_ON_WARNING), Y) + BASE_CPPCHECK_FLAGS += --error-exitcode=1 +endif +ifeq ($(CPPCHECK_QUIET), Y) + BASE_CPPCHECK_FLAGS += --quiet +endif + +# Output Messages +MSG_CPPCHECK_CMD := ' [CPPCHECK]:' + +# Checks the CPPCheck configuration as used in the user project, to determine if any paths are missing or invalid +cppcheck-config: $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_CPPCHECK_CMD) Checking cppcheck configuration check on source files + cppcheck $(BASE_CPPCHECK_FLAGS) --check-config $(CPPCHECK_FLAGS) $(SRC) + +# Runs a static analysis using CPPCheck to determine if there are any issues +cppcheck: $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_CPPCHECK_CMD) Performing static analysis on source files + cppcheck $(BASE_CPPCHECK_FLAGS) --enable=$(CPPCHECK_ENABLE) $(CPPCHECK_SUPPRESS:%=--suppress=%) $(CPPCHECK_FLAGS) $(SRC) + +# Phony build targets for this module +.PHONY: $(DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS) diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/dfu.md b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/dfu.md new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..456bbf6f5f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/dfu.md @@ -0,0 +1,122 @@ +DMBS - Dean's Makefile Build System +=================================== + + +Module: DFU +----------------- + +The DFU module provides build targets to program a USB connected target running +a DFU class bootloader, via the official Atmel FLIP utility running via the +command line, or the open source `DFU-Programmer` tool. + +## Importing This Module into a Makefile: + +To use this module in your application makefile, add the following code to your +makefile: + + include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk + +## Prerequisites: + +This module requires the `batchisp` utility to be available in your system's +`PATH` variable. The `batchisp` utility is distributed as part of Atmel's FLIP +software which can be downloaded from the [official site](http://www.atmel.com). + +This module requires the `dfu-programmer` utility to be available in your +system's `PATH` variable. The `dfu-programmer` utility is distributed from the +[official project site](https://dfu-programmer.github.io/). + +## Build Targets: + +The following targets are supported by this module: + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>flip</td> + <td>Program the application into the device's flash memory, using Atmel FLIP.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>flip-ee</td> + <td>Program the application's EEPROM data into the device's EEPROM memory, using Atmel FLIP.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>dfu</td> + <td>Program the application into the device's flash memory, using `dfu-programmer`.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>dfu-ee</td> + <td>Program the application's EEPROM data into the device's EEPROM memory, using `dfu-programmer`.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Mandatory Variables: + +The following variables must be defined (with a `NAME = VALUE` syntax, one +variable per line) in the user makefile to be able to use this module: + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>MCU</td> + <td>Name of the Atmel processor model (e.g. `at90usb1287`).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>TARGET</td> + <td>Name of the application output file prefix (e.g. `TestApplication`).</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Optional Variables: + +The following variables may be defined (with a `NAME = VALUE` syntax, one +variable per line) in the user makefile. If not specified, a default value will +be assumed. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>N/A</td> + <td>This module has no optional variables.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Provided Variables: + +The following variables may be referenced in a user makefile (via `$(NAME)` +syntax) if desired, as they are provided by this module. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>N/A</td> + <td>This module provides no variables.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Provided Macros: + +The following macros may be referenced in a user makefile (via +`$(call NAME, ARG1, ARG2, ...)` syntax) if desired, as they are provided by +this module. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>N/A</td> + <td>This module provides no macros.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Module Changelog: + +The changes to this module since its initial release are listed below, as of the +DMBS version where the change was made. + +### 20160403 +Initial release. diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/dfu.mk b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/dfu.mk new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1eb22b864f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/dfu.mk @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +# +# DMBS Build System +# Released into the public domain. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.fourwalledcubicle.com +# + +DMBS_BUILD_MODULES += DFU +DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS += flip flip-ee dfu dfu-ee +DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS += MCU TARGET +DMBS_BUILD_OPTIONAL_VARS += +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_VARS += +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_MACROS += + +# Conditionally import the CORE module of DMBS if it is not already imported +DMBS_MODULE_PATH := $(patsubst %/,%,$(dir $(lastword $(MAKEFILE_LIST)))) +ifeq ($(findstring CORE, $(DMBS_BUILD_MODULES)),) + include $(DMBS_MODULE_PATH)/core.mk +endif + +# Sanity-check values of mandatory user-supplied variables +$(foreach MANDATORY_VAR, $(DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS), $(call ERROR_IF_UNSET, $(MANDATORY_VAR))) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, MCU) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, TARGET) + +# Output Messages +MSG_COPY_CMD := ' [CP] :' +MSG_REMOVE_CMD := ' [RM] :' +MSG_DFU_CMD := ' [DFU] :' + +# Programs in the target FLASH memory using BATCHISP, the command line tool used by FLIP +flip: $(TARGET).hex $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_DFU_CMD) Programming FLASH with batchisp using \"$<\" + batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation erase f loadbuffer $< program + batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0 + +# Programs in the target EEPROM memory using BATCHISP, the command line tool used by FLIP +flip-ee: $(TARGET).eep $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_COPY_CMD) Copying EEP file to temporary file \"$<.hex\" + cp $< $<.hex + @echo $(MSG_DFU_CMD) Programming EEPROM with batchisp using \"$<.hex\" + batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM loadbuffer $<.hex program + batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0 + @echo $(MSG_REMOVE_CMD) Removing temporary file \"$<.hex\" + rm $<.hex + +# Programs in the target FLASH memory using DFU-PROGRAMMER +dfu: $(TARGET).hex $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_DFU_CMD) Programming FLASH with dfu-programmer using \"$<\" + dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase + dfu-programmer $(MCU) flash $< + dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset + +# Programs in the target EEPROM memory using DFU-PROGRAMMER +dfu-ee: $(TARGET).eep $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_DFU_CMD) Programming EEPROM with dfu-programmer using \"$<\" + dfu-programmer $(MCU) flash --eeprom $< + dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset + +# Phony build targets for this module +.PHONY: $(DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS) diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/doxygen.md b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/doxygen.md new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..837704aca0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/doxygen.md @@ -0,0 +1,118 @@ +DMBS - Dean's Makefile Build System +=================================== + + +Module: DOXYGEN +----------------- + +The DOXYGEN module provides build targets to automatically generate API +documentation for a project, using the open-source Doxygen tool. + +## Importing This Module into a Makefile: + +To use this module in your application makefile, add the following code to your +makefile: + + include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk + +## Prerequisites: + +This module requires the `doxygen` utility to be available in your system's +`PATH` variable. The `doxygen` utility is distributed on the project's +[official site](http://doxygen.org/) but is also +made available in many *nix operating system's package managers. + +## Build Targets: + +The following targets are supported by this module: + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>doxygen</td> + <td>Generate project documentation, via Doxygen.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>doxygen-create</td> + <td>Create a new project Doxygen template, which can then be customized.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>doxygen-upgrade</td> + <td>Upgrade an existing project Doxygen template to the latest Doxygen version.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Mandatory Variables: + +The following variables must be defined (with a `NAME = VALUE` syntax, one +variable per line) in the user makefile to be able to use this module: + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>N/A</td> + <td>This module has no mandatory variables.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Optional Variables: + +The following variables may be defined (with a `NAME = VALUE` syntax, one +variable per line) in the user makefile. If not specified, a default value will +be assumed. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>DOXYGEN_CONF</td> + <td>Name of the Doxygen project configuration file that should be used when generating documentation, or creating/upgrading the configuration file.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>DOXYGEN_FAIL_ON_WARNING</td> + <td>Boolean, if `Y` the build will fail if Doxygen encounters any errors or warnings. If `N`, fail only on errors. Default is `Y`.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>DOXYGEN_OVERRIDE_PARAMS</td> + <td>List of `NAME=VALUE` parameters which should override the values specified in the project configuration file, when building documentation.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Provided Variables: + +The following variables may be referenced in a user makefile (via `$(NAME)` +syntax) if desired, as they are provided by this module. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>N/A</td> + <td>This module provides no variables.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Provided Macros: + +The following macros may be referenced in a user makefile (via +`$(call NAME, ARG1, ARG2, ...)` syntax) if desired, as they are provided by +this module. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>N/A</td> + <td>This module provides no macros.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Module Changelog: + +The changes to this module since its initial release are listed below, as of the +DMBS version where the change was made. + +### 20160403 +Initial release. diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/doxygen.mk b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/doxygen.mk new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..45639ad156 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/doxygen.mk @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +# +# DMBS Build System +# Released into the public domain. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.fourwalledcubicle.com +# + +DMBS_BUILD_MODULES += DOXYGEN +DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS += doxygen doxygen-upgrade doxygen-create +DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS += +DMBS_BUILD_OPTIONAL_VARS += DOXYGEN_CONF DOXYGEN_FAIL_ON_WARNING DOXYGEN_OVERRIDE_PARAMS +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_VARS += +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_MACROS += + +# Conditionally import the CORE module of DMBS if it is not already imported +DMBS_MODULE_PATH := $(patsubst %/,%,$(dir $(lastword $(MAKEFILE_LIST)))) +ifeq ($(findstring CORE, $(DMBS_BUILD_MODULES)),) + include $(DMBS_MODULE_PATH)/core.mk +endif + +# Default values of optionally user-supplied variables +DOXYGEN_CONF ?= doxyfile +DOXYGEN_FAIL_ON_WARNING ?= Y +DOXYGEN_OVERRIDE_PARAMS ?= QUIET=YES + +# Sanity check user supplied values +$(foreach MANDATORY_VAR, $(DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS), $(call ERROR_IF_UNSET, $(MANDATORY_VAR))) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, DOXYGEN_CONF) +$(call ERROR_IF_NONBOOL, DOXYGEN_FAIL_ON_WARNING) + +# Output Messages +MSG_DOXYGEN_CMD := ' [DOXYGEN] :' + +# Determine Doxygen invocation command +BASE_DOXYGEN_CMD := ( cat $(DOXYGEN_CONF) $(DOXYGEN_OVERRIDE_PARAMS:%=; echo "%") ) | doxygen - +ifeq ($(DOXYGEN_FAIL_ON_WARNING), Y) + DOXYGEN_CMD := if ( $(BASE_DOXYGEN_CMD) 2>&1 | grep -v "warning: ignoring unsupported tag" ;); then exit 1; fi; +else + DOXYGEN_CMD := $(BASE_DOXYGEN_CMD) +endif + +# Error if the specified Doxygen configuration file does not exist +$(DOXYGEN_CONF): + $(error Doxygen configuration file $@ does not exist) + +# Builds the project documentation using the specified configuration file and the DOXYGEN tool +doxygen: $(DOXYGEN_CONF) $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_DOXYGEN_CMD) Configuration file \"$(DOXYGEN_CONF)\" with parameters \"$(DOXYGEN_OVERRIDE_PARAMS)\" + $(DOXYGEN_CMD) + +# Upgrades an existing Doxygen configuration file to the latest Doxygen template, preserving settings +doxygen-upgrade: $(DOXYGEN_CONF) $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_DOXYGEN_CMD) Upgrading configuration file \"$(DOXYGEN_CONF)\" with latest template + doxygen -u $(DOXYGEN_CONF) > /dev/null + +# Creates a new Doxygen configuration file with the set file name +doxygen-create: $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_DOXYGEN_CMD) Creating new configuration file \"$(DOXYGEN_CONF)\" with latest template + doxygen -g $(DOXYGEN_CONF) > /dev/null + + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/gcc.md b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/gcc.md new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d28fd9ae45 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/gcc.md @@ -0,0 +1,211 @@ +DMBS - Dean's Makefile Build System +=================================== + + +Module: GCC +----------------- + +The GCC module provides build targets to compile a user application, using a +variant of GCC for a specific target architecture (such as `avr-gcc`). + +## Importing This Module into a Makefile: + +To use this module in your application makefile, add the following code to your +makefile: + + include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk + +## Prerequisites: + +This module requires the GCC compiler to be installed and available in the +system's `PATH` variable for the desired target architecture. + +## Build Targets: + +The following targets are supported by this module: + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>size</td> + <td>Show the compiled binary size for the various memory segments.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>symbol-sizes</td> + <td>Show the size of each symbol in the compiled binary (useful to find large functions to optimize further).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>all</td> + <td>Build application and generate all binary (BIN, ELF, HEX) and auxiliary (LSS, MAP, SYM, etc.) output files.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>lib</td> + <td>Generate a static `.a` library from the application code, containing the flash region's data.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>elf</td> + <td>Generate an ELF debug file from the application code, containing all region's data.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>bin</td> + <td>Generate a flat BIN binary file from the application code, containing the flash region's data.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>hex</td> + <td>Generate a pair of Intel HEX files from the application code, containing the flash region's data (HEX) and EEPROM data (EEP).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>lss</td> + <td>Generate a LSS listing file showing the disassembly of the compiled application.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>clean</td> + <td>Remove all generated project intermediary and binary output files.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>mostlyclean</td> + <td>Remove all generated project intermediary output files, but preserve the binary output files.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Mandatory Variables: + +The following variables must be defined (with a `NAME = VALUE` syntax, one +variable per line) in the user makefile to be able to use this module: + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>MCU</td> + <td>Name of the Atmel processor model (e.g. `at90usb1287`).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>TARGET</td> + <td>Name of the application output file prefix (e.g. `TestApplication`).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>ARCH</td> + <td>Target device architecture (e.g. `AVR8`).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>SRC</td> + <td>List of all project source files (C, C++, ASM).</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Optional Variables: + +The following variables may be defined (with a `NAME = VALUE` syntax, one +variable per line) in the user makefile. If not specified, a default value will +be assumed. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>COMPILER_PATH</td> + <td>Path to the compiler to use, in case a specific compiler should be substituted for the one in the system's `PATH` variable. Default is blank (use `PATH` provided compiler).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>OPTIMIZATION</td> + <td>Optimization level to use when compiling C and C++ source files. Default is `s` (optimize for smallest size).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>C_STANDARD</td> + <td>C language standard used when compiling C language source files. Default is `gnu99` (C99 standard with GNU extensions)./td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>CPP_STANDARD</td> + <td>C++ language standard used when compiling C++ language source files. Default is `gnu++98` (C++98 standard with GNU extensions)./td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>F_CPU</td> + <td>Processor core clock frequency, in Hz. This is used by some architectures for functions such as software spin-loop delays. Default is blank (no value defined).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>C_FLAGS</td> + <td>Common GCC flags passed to the compiler for C language (C) input files. Default is blank (no additional flags).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>CPP_FLAGS</td> + <td>Common GCC flags passed to the compiler for C++ language (CPP) input files. Default is blank (no additional flags).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>ASM_FLAGS</td> + <td>Common GCC flags passed to the assembler for assembly language (S) input files. Default is blank (no additional flags).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>CC_FLAGS</td> + <td>Common GCC flags passed to the compiler for all source file types. Default is blank (no additional flags).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>LD_FLAGS</td> + <td>Extra flags to pass to the GNU linker when linking the compiled object files into the resulting binary. Default is blank (no additional flags).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>LINKER_RELAXATIONS</td> + <td>Boolean, if `Y` linker relaxations will be enabled to slightly reduce the resulting binary's size. Default is `Y`.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>JUMP_TABLES</td> + <td>Boolean, if `Y` jump tables will be enabled to slightly reduce the resulting binary's size - note that this can cause incorrect jumps if the binary is relocated after compilation, such as for a bootloader. Default is `N`.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>OBJDIR</td> + <td>Directory to store the intermediate object files, as they are generated from the source files. Default is `obj`.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>OBJECT_FILES</td> + <td>List of additional `.o` object files to link into the final binary. Default is blank (no additional objects).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>DEBUG_FORMAT</td> + <td>Debug ELF file format to generate. Default is `dwarf-2`.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>DEBUG_LEVEL</td> + <td>Level of the debugging information to generate in the compiled object files. Debug is 2 (medium level debugging information).</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Provided Variables: + +The following variables may be referenced in a user makefile (via `$(NAME)` +syntax) if desired, as they are provided by this module. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>N/A</td> + <td>This module provides no variables.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Provided Macros: + +The following macros may be referenced in a user makefile (via +`$(call NAME, ARG1, ARG2, ...)` syntax) if desired, as they are provided by +this module. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>N/A</td> + <td>This module provides no macros.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Module Changelog: + +The changes to this module since its initial release are listed below, as of the +DMBS version where the change was made. + +### 20170426 +Added `JUMP_TABLES` optional variable. + +### 20160403 +Initial release. diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/gcc.mk b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/gcc.mk new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6126cf97fc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/gcc.mk @@ -0,0 +1,273 @@ +# +# DMBS Build System +# Released into the public domain. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.fourwalledcubicle.com +# + +DMBS_BUILD_MODULES += GCC +DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS += size symbol-sizes all lib elf bin hex lss clean mostlyclean +DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS += TARGET ARCH MCU SRC +DMBS_BUILD_OPTIONAL_VARS += COMPILER_PATH OPTIMIZATION C_STANDARD CPP_STANDARD F_CPU C_FLAGS CPP_FLAGS ASM_FLAGS CC_FLAGS LD_FLAGS OBJDIR OBJECT_FILES DEBUG_TYPE DEBUG_LEVEL LINKER_RELAXATIONS JUMP_TABLES +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_VARS += +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_MACROS += + +# Conditionally import the CORE module of DMBS if it is not already imported +DMBS_MODULE_PATH := $(patsubst %/,%,$(dir $(lastword $(MAKEFILE_LIST)))) +ifeq ($(findstring CORE, $(DMBS_BUILD_MODULES)),) + include $(DMBS_MODULE_PATH)/core.mk +endif + +# Default values of optionally user-supplied variables +COMPILER_PATH ?= +OPTIMIZATION ?= s +F_CPU ?= +C_STANDARD ?= gnu99 +CPP_STANDARD ?= gnu++98 +C_FLAGS ?= +CPP_FLAGS ?= +ASM_FLAGS ?= +CC_FLAGS ?= +OBJDIR ?= obj +OBJECT_FILES ?= +DEBUG_FORMAT ?= dwarf-2 +DEBUG_LEVEL ?= 2 +LINKER_RELAXATIONS ?= Y +JUMP_TABLES ?= N + +# Sanity check user supplied values +$(foreach MANDATORY_VAR, $(DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS), $(call ERROR_IF_UNSET, $(MANDATORY_VAR))) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, MCU) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, TARGET) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, ARCH) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, OPTIMIZATION) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, C_STANDARD) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, CPP_STANDARD) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, OBJDIR) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, DEBUG_FORMAT) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, DEBUG_LEVEL) +$(call ERROR_IF_NONBOOL, LINKER_RELAXATIONS) +$(call ERROR_IF_NONBOOL, JUMP_TABLES) + +# Determine the utility prefix to use for the selected architecture +ifeq ($(ARCH), AVR8) + CROSS := $(COMPILER_PATH)avr +else ifeq ($(ARCH), XMEGA) + CROSS := $(COMPILER_PATH)avr +else ifeq ($(ARCH), UC3) + CROSS := $(COMPILER_PATH)avr32 +else + $(error Unsupported architecture "$(ARCH)") +endif + +# Output Messages +MSG_INFO_MESSAGE := ' [INFO] :' +MSG_COMPILE_CMD := ' [GCC] :' +MSG_ASSEMBLE_CMD := ' [GAS] :' +MSG_NM_CMD := ' [NM] :' +MSG_REMOVE_CMD := ' [RM] :' +MSG_LINK_CMD := ' [LNK] :' +MSG_ARCHIVE_CMD := ' [AR] :' +MSG_SIZE_CMD := ' [SIZE] :' +MSG_OBJCPY_CMD := ' [OBJCPY] :' +MSG_OBJDMP_CMD := ' [OBJDMP] :' + +# Convert input source file list to differentiate them by type +C_SOURCE := $(filter %.c, $(SRC)) +CPP_SOURCE := $(filter %.cpp, $(SRC)) +ASM_SOURCE := $(filter %.S, $(SRC)) + +# Create a list of unknown source file types, if any are found throw an error +UNKNOWN_SOURCE := $(filter-out $(C_SOURCE) $(CPP_SOURCE) $(ASM_SOURCE), $(SRC)) +ifneq ($(UNKNOWN_SOURCE),) + $(error Unknown input source file formats: $(UNKNOWN_SOURCE)) +endif + +# Convert input source filenames into a list of required output object files +OBJECT_FILES += $(addsuffix .o, $(basename $(SRC))) + +# Check if an output object file directory was specified instead of the input file location +ifneq ($(OBJDIR),.) + # Prefix all the object filenames with the output object file directory path + OBJECT_FILES := $(addprefix $(patsubst %/,%,$(OBJDIR))/, $(notdir $(OBJECT_FILES))) + + # Check if any object file (without path) appears more than once in the object file list + ifneq ($(words $(sort $(OBJECT_FILES))), $(words $(OBJECT_FILES))) + $(error Cannot build with OBJDIR parameter set - one or more object file name is not unique) + endif + + # Create the output object file directory if it does not exist and add it to the virtual path list + $(shell mkdir -p $(OBJDIR) 2> /dev/null) + VPATH += $(dir $(SRC)) +endif + +# Create a list of dependency files from the list of object files +DEPENDENCY_FILES := $(OBJECT_FILES:%.o=%.d) + +# Create a list of common flags to pass to the compiler/linker/assembler +BASE_CC_FLAGS := -pipe -g$(DEBUG_FORMAT) -g$(DEBUG_LEVEL) +ifneq ($(findstring $(ARCH), AVR8 XMEGA),) + BASE_CC_FLAGS += -mmcu=$(MCU) -fshort-enums -fno-inline-small-functions -fpack-struct +else ifneq ($(findstring $(ARCH), UC3),) + BASE_CC_FLAGS += -mpart=$(MCU:at32%=%) -masm-addr-pseudos +endif +BASE_CC_FLAGS += -Wall -fno-strict-aliasing -funsigned-char -funsigned-bitfields -ffunction-sections +BASE_CC_FLAGS += -I. +BASE_CC_FLAGS += -DARCH=ARCH_$(ARCH) +ifneq ($(F_CPU),) + BASE_CC_FLAGS += -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL +endif +ifeq ($(LINKER_RELAXATIONS), Y) + BASE_CC_FLAGS += -mrelax +endif +ifeq ($(JUMP_TABLES), N) + # This flag is required for bootloaders as GCC will emit invalid jump table + # assembly code for devices with large amounts of flash; the jump table target + # is extracted from FLASH without using the correct ELPM instruction, resulting + # in a pseudo-random jump target. + BASE_CC_FLAGS += -fno-jump-tables +endif + +# Additional language specific compiler flags +BASE_C_FLAGS := -x c -O$(OPTIMIZATION) -std=$(C_STANDARD) -Wstrict-prototypes +BASE_CPP_FLAGS := -x c++ -O$(OPTIMIZATION) -std=$(CPP_STANDARD) +BASE_ASM_FLAGS := -x assembler-with-cpp + +# Create a list of flags to pass to the linker +BASE_LD_FLAGS := -lm -Wl,-Map=$(TARGET).map,--cref -Wl,--gc-sections +ifeq ($(LINKER_RELAXATIONS), Y) + BASE_LD_FLAGS += -Wl,--relax +endif +ifneq ($(findstring $(ARCH), AVR8 XMEGA),) + BASE_LD_FLAGS += -mmcu=$(MCU) +else ifneq ($(findstring $(ARCH), UC3),) + BASE_LD_FLAGS += -mpart=$(MCU:at32%=%) --rodata-writable --direct-data +endif + +# Determine flags to pass to the size utility based on its reported features (only invoke if size target required) +# and on an architecture where this non-standard patch is available +ifneq ($(ARCH), UC3) +size: SIZE_MCU_FLAG := $(shell $(CROSS)-size --help | grep -- --mcu > /dev/null && echo --mcu=$(MCU) ) +size: SIZE_FORMAT_FLAG := $(shell $(CROSS)-size --help | grep -- --format=.*avr > /dev/null && echo --format=avr ) +endif + +# Pre-build informational target, to give compiler and project name information when building +build_begin: + @echo $(MSG_INFO_MESSAGE) Begin compilation of project \"$(TARGET)\"... + @echo "" + @$(CROSS)-gcc --version + +# Post-build informational target, to project name information when building has completed +build_end: + @echo $(MSG_INFO_MESSAGE) Finished building project \"$(TARGET)\". + +# Prints size information of a compiled application (FLASH, RAM and EEPROM usages) +size: $(TARGET).elf + @echo $(MSG_SIZE_CMD) Determining size of \"$<\" + @echo "" + $(CROSS)-size $(SIZE_MCU_FLAG) $(SIZE_FORMAT_FLAG) $< + +# Prints size information on the symbols within a compiled application in decimal bytes +symbol-sizes: $(TARGET).elf + @echo $(MSG_NM_CMD) Extracting \"$<\" symbols with decimal byte sizes + $(CROSS)-nm --size-sort --demangle --radix=d $< + +# Cleans intermediary build files, leaving only the compiled application files +mostlyclean: + @echo $(MSG_REMOVE_CMD) Removing object files of \"$(TARGET)\" + rm -f $(OBJECT_FILES) + @echo $(MSG_REMOVE_CMD) Removing dependency files of \"$(TARGET)\" + rm -f $(DEPENDENCY_FILES) + +# Cleans all build files, leaving only the original source code +clean: mostlyclean + @echo $(MSG_REMOVE_CMD) Removing output files of \"$(TARGET)\" + rm -f $(TARGET).elf $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).bin $(TARGET).eep $(TARGET).map $(TARGET).lss $(TARGET).sym lib$(TARGET).a + +# Performs a complete build of the user application and prints size information afterwards +all: build_begin elf hex bin lss sym size build_end + +# Helper targets, to build a specific type of output file without having to know the project target name +lib: lib$(TARGET).a +elf: $(TARGET).elf +hex: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep +bin: $(TARGET).bin +lss: $(TARGET).lss +sym: $(TARGET).sym + +# Default target to *create* the user application's specified source files; if this rule is executed by +# make, the input source file doesn't exist and an error needs to be presented to the user +$(SRC): + $(error Source file does not exist: $@) + +# Compiles an input C source file and generates an assembly listing for it +%.s: %.c $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_COMPILE_CMD) Generating assembly from C file \"$(notdir $<)\" + $(CROSS)-gcc -S $(BASE_CC_FLAGS) $(BASE_C_FLAGS) $(CC_FLAGS) $(C_FLAGS) $< -o $@ + +# Compiles an input C++ source file and generates an assembly listing for it +%.s: %.cpp $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_COMPILE_CMD) Generating assembly from C++ file \"$(notdir $<)\" + $(CROSS)-gcc -S $(BASE_CC_FLAGS) $(BASE_CPP_FLAGS) $(CC_FLAGS) $(CPP_FLAGS) $< -o $@ + +# Compiles an input C source file and generates a linkable object file for it +$(OBJDIR)/%.o: %.c $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_COMPILE_CMD) Compiling C file \"$(notdir $<)\" + $(CROSS)-gcc -c $(BASE_CC_FLAGS) $(BASE_C_FLAGS) $(CC_FLAGS) $(C_FLAGS) -MMD -MP -MF $(@:%.o=%.d) $< -o $@ + +# Compiles an input C++ source file and generates a linkable object file for it +$(OBJDIR)/%.o: %.cpp $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_COMPILE_CMD) Compiling C++ file \"$(notdir $<)\" + $(CROSS)-gcc -c $(BASE_CC_FLAGS) $(BASE_CPP_FLAGS) $(CC_FLAGS) $(CPP_FLAGS) -MMD -MP -MF $(@:%.o=%.d) $< -o $@ + +# Assembles an input ASM source file and generates a linkable object file for it +$(OBJDIR)/%.o: %.S $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_ASSEMBLE_CMD) Assembling \"$(notdir $<)\" + $(CROSS)-gcc -c $(BASE_CC_FLAGS) $(BASE_ASM_FLAGS) $(CC_FLAGS) $(ASM_FLAGS) -MMD -MP -MF $(@:%.o=%.d) $< -o $@ + +# Generates a library archive file from the user application, which can be linked into other applications +.PRECIOUS : $(OBJECT_FILES) +.SECONDARY : %.a +%.a: $(OBJECT_FILES) + @echo $(MSG_ARCHIVE_CMD) Archiving object files into \"$@\" + $(CROSS)-ar rcs $@ $(OBJECT_FILES) + +# Generates an ELF debug file from the user application, which can be further processed for FLASH and EEPROM data +# files, or used for programming and debugging directly +.PRECIOUS : $(OBJECT_FILES) +.SECONDARY : %.elf +%.elf: $(OBJECT_FILES) + @echo $(MSG_LINK_CMD) Linking object files into \"$@\" + $(CROSS)-gcc $^ -o $@ $(BASE_LD_FLAGS) $(LD_FLAGS) + +# Extracts out the loadable FLASH memory data from the project ELF file, and creates an Intel HEX format file of it +%.hex: %.elf + @echo $(MSG_OBJCPY_CMD) Extracting HEX file data from \"$<\" + $(CROSS)-objcopy -O ihex -R .eeprom -R .fuse -R .lock -R .signature $< $@ + +# Extracts out the loadable FLASH memory data from the project ELF file, and creates an Binary format file of it +%.bin: %.elf + @echo $(MSG_OBJCPY_CMD) Extracting BIN file data from \"$<\" + $(CROSS)-objcopy -O binary -R .eeprom -R .fuse -R .lock -R .signature $< $@ + +# Extracts out the loadable EEPROM memory data from the project ELF file, and creates an Intel HEX format file of it +%.eep: %.elf + @echo $(MSG_OBJCPY_CMD) Extracting EEP file data from \"$<\" + $(CROSS)-objcopy -O ihex -j .eeprom --set-section-flags=.eeprom="alloc,load" --change-section-lma .eeprom=0 --no-change-warnings $< $@ || exit 0 + +# Creates an assembly listing file from an input project ELF file, containing interleaved assembly and source data +%.lss: %.elf + @echo $(MSG_OBJDMP_CMD) Extracting LSS file data from \"$<\" + $(CROSS)-objdump -h -d -S -z $< > $@ + +# Creates a symbol file listing the loadable and discarded symbols from an input project ELF file +%.sym: %.elf + @echo $(MSG_NM_CMD) Extracting SYM file data from \"$<\" + $(CROSS)-nm -n $< > $@ + +# Include build dependency files +-include $(DEPENDENCY_FILES) + +# Phony build targets for this module +.PHONY: build_begin build_end $(DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS) diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/hid.md b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/hid.md new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b2dfbf7136 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/hid.md @@ -0,0 +1,129 @@ +DMBS - Dean's Makefile Build System +=================================== + + +Module: HID +----------------- + +The HID module provides build targets to program a target running a PJRC Teensy +or LUFA compatible HID class bootloader. + +## Importing This Module into a Makefile: + +To use this module in your application makefile, add the following code to your +makefile: + + include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk + +## Prerequisites: + +This module requires the `teensy_loader_cli` utility to be available in your +system's `PATH` variable. The `teensy_loader_cli` utility is distributed in +a modified form (from PJRC) in the LUFA project's +[official site](http://www.lufa-lib.org/), but is also +made available in its original form directly from the +[PJRC website](https://www.pjrc.com/teensy/loader_cli.html). Note that the +original tool works with Teensy boards only, and not LUFA HID bootloader +devices. + +This module requires the `hid_bootloader_cli` utility to be available in your +system's `PATH` variable. The `hid_bootloader_cli` Python script utility is +distributed in LUFA project's [official site](http://www.lufa-lib.org/). + +This module requires the AVR-GCC compiler to be installed and available in the +system's `PATH` variable. + +## Build Targets: + +The following targets are supported by this module: + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>hid</td> + <td>Program a LUFA HID class bootloader device, using the `hid_bootloader_cli.py` Python script.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>hid-ee</td> + <td>Program a LUFA HID class bootloader device's EEPROM, using the `hid_bootloader_cli.py` Python script and a shim application which is programmed into the target's flash.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>teensy</td> + <td>Program a LUFA HID class bootloader device or Teensy board, using the `teensy_loader_cli` tool.</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>teensy-ee</td> + <td>Program a LUFA HID class bootloader device's EEPROM, using the `teensy_loader_cli` tool and a shim application which is programmed into the target's flash.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Mandatory Variables: + +The following variables must be defined (with a `NAME = VALUE` syntax, one +variable per line) in the user makefile to be able to use this module: + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>MCU</td> + <td>Name of the Atmel processor model (e.g. `at90usb1287`).</td> + </tr> + <tr> + <td>TARGET</td> + <td>Name of the application output file prefix (e.g. `TestApplication`).</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Optional Variables: + +The following variables may be defined (with a `NAME = VALUE` syntax, one +variable per line) in the user makefile. If not specified, a default value will +be assumed. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>N/A</td> + <td>This module has no optional variables.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Provided Variables: + +The following variables may be referenced in a user makefile (via `$(NAME)` +syntax) if desired, as they are provided by this module. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>N/A</td> + <td>This module provides no variables.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Provided Macros: + +The following macros may be referenced in a user makefile (via +`$(call NAME, ARG1, ARG2, ...)` syntax) if desired, as they are provided by +this module. + +<table> + <tbody> + <tr> + <td>N/A</td> + <td>This module provides no macros.</td> + </tr> + </tbody> +</table> + +## Module Changelog: + +The changes to this module since its initial release are listed below, as of the +DMBS version where the change was made. + +### 20160403 +Initial release. diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/hid.mk b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/hid.mk new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7a0ad9d0e6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/DMBS/hid.mk @@ -0,0 +1,57 @@ +# +# DMBS Build System +# Released into the public domain. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.fourwalledcubicle.com +# + +DMBS_BUILD_MODULES += HID +DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS += hid hid-ee teensy teensy-ee +DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS += MCU TARGET +DMBS_BUILD_OPTIONAL_VARS += +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_VARS += +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_MACROS += + +# Conditionally import the CORE module of DMBS if it is not already imported +DMBS_MODULE_PATH := $(patsubst %/,%,$(dir $(lastword $(MAKEFILE_LIST)))) +ifeq ($(findstring CORE, $(DMBS_BUILD_MODULES)),) + include $(DMBS_MODULE_PATH)/core.mk +endif + +# Sanity-check values of mandatory user-supplied variables +$(foreach MANDATORY_VAR, $(DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS), $(call ERROR_IF_UNSET, $(MANDATORY_VAR))) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, MCU) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, TARGET) + +# Output Messages +MSG_HID_BOOTLOADER_CMD := ' [HID] :' +MSG_OBJCPY_CMD := ' [OBJCPY] :' +MSG_MAKE_CMD := ' [MAKE] :' + +# Programs in the target FLASH memory using the HID_BOOTLOADER_CLI tool +hid: $(TARGET).hex $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_HID_BOOTLOADER_CMD) Programming FLASH with hid_bootloader_cli using \"$<\" + hid_bootloader_cli -mmcu=$(MCU) -v $< + +# Programs in the target EEPROM memory using the HID_BOOTLOADER_CLI tool (note: clears target FLASH memory) +hid-ee: $(TARGET).eep $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_OBJCPY_CMD) Converting \"$<\" to a binary file \"InputEEData.bin\" + avr-objcopy -I ihex -O binary $< $(DMBS_MODULE_PATH)/HID_EEPROM_Loader/InputEEData.bin + @echo $(MSG_MAKE_CMD) Making EEPROM loader application for \"$<\" + $(MAKE) -C $(DMBS_MODULE_PATH)/HID_EEPROM_Loader/ MCU=$(MCU) clean hid + +# Programs in the target FLASH memory using the TEENSY_BOOTLOADER_CLI tool +teensy: $(TARGET).hex $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_HID_BOOTLOADER_CMD) Programming FLASH with teensy_loader_cli using \"$<\" + teensy_loader_cli -mmcu=$(MCU) -v $< + +# Programs in the target EEPROM memory using the TEENSY_BOOTLOADER_CLI tool (note: clears target FLASH memory) +teensy-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(MAKEFILE_LIST) + @echo $(MSG_OBJCPY_CMD) Converting \"$<\" to a binary file \"InputEEData.bin\" + avr-objcopy -I ihex -O binary $< $(DMBS_MODULE_PATH)/HID_EEPROM_Loader/InputEEData.bin + @echo $(MSG_MAKE_CMD) Making EEPROM loader application for \"$<\" + $(MAKE) -s -C $(DMBS_MODULE_PATH)/HID_EEPROM_Loader/ MCU=$(MCU) clean teensy + +# Phony build targets for this module +.PHONY: $(DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS) diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/Readme.md b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/Readme.md new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f4f7a5f15c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/Readme.md @@ -0,0 +1,123 @@ +DMBS - Dean's Makefile Build System +=================================== + + +Project Overview +---------------- + +GNU Make is scary, and it's tough to get the rules right sometimes. Many +projects get by via simple copy-pasting of old makefiles, resulting in many +redundant copies of the same old rules. DMBS aims to solve this by providing a +simple modular set of makefiles which can be included by your project to quickly +add various build functionality. + +This aims to replace the old WinAVR "mfile" makefile template, giving better +functionality and much simpler user makefiles. + + +Benefits: +---------------- + +Apart from much simpler, cleaner makefiles DMBS carries the aim of making the +process of troubleshooting build issues a little easier. Lots can go wrong, so +DMBS tries to sanity check its inputs wherever possible, and produce +human-readable error messages. Forgotten to set a variable? Get a +`Makefile {X} value not set.` message, rather than a possibly unrelated message. +Have the wrong filename? See `Source file does not exist: {X}` rather than the +infamous `No rule to make target {X}` message. + + +Use: +---------------- + +A template user makefile is provided in the `Template` directory. DMBS modules +are included via a GNU Make `include` directive. While the DMBS `core` module is +always required, you can pick and choose what other modules you wish to add to +your user project. + +[See here for the documentation on the individual modules provided by DMBS.](DMBS/ModulesOverview.md) +If you're interested in writing your own DMBS module(s), [see here.](DMBS/WritingYourOwnModules.md) + +Here's an example user makefile: + + MCU = atmega128 + ARCH = AVR8 + F_CPU = 8000000 + OPTIMIZATION = s + TARGET = Template + SRC = $(TARGET).c + CC_FLAGS = + LD_FLAGS = + + # Default target + all: + + # Include DMBS build script makefiles + DMBS_PATH ?= ../DMBS + include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk + include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk + include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk + include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk + include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk + include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk + include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk + include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk + +Each DMBS module can optionally supply one or more Make variables and macros, +which you can reference in your user makefile. Additionally, modules can require +one or more variables to be set by the user makefile, with (in some cases) sane +defaults used if left out. + +As modules are added, you can get a list of available targets by simply typing +`make help` from the command line. This will produce a formatted list of targets +as well as mandatory and optional variables and exposed variables and macros. + + +Distribution +---------------- + +You can embed DMBS in your project any way you like - some options are: +1. A git submodule +2. A source tarball +3. A manually copied extracted archive + +The intention of DMBS is that users can just import it from whatever source +they like. If your project needs to extend the existing modules in an unusual +manner, or if you want to provide your own modules, you can include them in +your project repository (or submit a patch to DMBS if your module is generic +enough to warrant wide use). + + +License +---------------- + +DMBS is released into the public domain, making is suitable for use everywhere, +by everyone. Contributions are greatly appreciated however, in order to make +DMBS better for everyone. + +The actual license text is as follows: + + This is free and unencumbered software released into the public domain. + + Anyone is free to copy, modify, publish, use, compile, sell, or + distribute this software, either in source code form or as a compiled + binary, for any purpose, commercial or non-commercial, and by any + means. + + In jurisdictions that recognize copyright laws, the author or authors + of this software dedicate any and all copyright interest in the + software to the public domain. We make this dedication for the benefit + of the public at large and to the detriment of our heirs and + successors. We intend this dedication to be an overt act of + relinquishment in perpetuity of all present and future rights to this + software under copyright law. + + THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, + EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF + MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. + IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR + OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, + ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR + OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. + + For more information, please refer to <http://unlicense.org/> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/Template/Template.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/Template/Template.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..95d36f7dbf --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/Template/Template.c @@ -0,0 +1,12 @@ +/* + DMBS Build System + Released into the public domain. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.fourwalledcubicle.com + */ + +int main(void) +{ + // Application code here. +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/Template/makefile b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/Template/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d88292388c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/DMBS/Template/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,32 @@ +# +# DMBS Build System +# Released into the public domain. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.fourwalledcubicle.com +# + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = atmega128 +ARCH = AVR8 +F_CPU = 8000000 +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = Template +SRC = $(TARGET).c +CC_FLAGS = +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include DMBS build script makefiles +DMBS_PATH ?= ../DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/LUFA/lufa-gcc.mk b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/LUFA/lufa-gcc.mk new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f824362e4d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/LUFA/lufa-gcc.mk @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2015. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +DMBS_BUILD_MODULES += LUFA_GCC +DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS += +DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS += LUFA_PATH ARCH F_USB +DMBS_BUILD_OPTIONAL_VARS += BOARD +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_VARS += +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_MACROS += + +SHELL = /bin/sh + +ERROR_IF_UNSET ?= $(if $(filter undefined, $(origin $(strip $(1)))), $(error Makefile $(strip $(1)) value not set)) +ERROR_IF_EMPTY ?= $(if $(strip $($(strip $(1)))), , $(error Makefile $(strip $(1)) option cannot be blank)) +ERROR_IF_NONBOOL ?= $(if $(filter Y N, $($(strip $(1)))), , $(error Makefile $(strip $(1)) option must be Y or N)) + +# Sanity check user supplied values +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, LUFA_PATH) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, ARCH) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, F_USB) + +# Default values of optionally user-supplied variables +BOARD ?= NONE + +# Determine the utility prefix to use for the selected architecture +ifeq ($(ARCH), XMEGA) + $(warning The XMEGA device support is currently EXPERIMENTAL (incomplete and/or non-functional), and is included for preview purposes only.) +else ifeq ($(ARCH), UC3) + $(warning The UC3 device support is currently EXPERIMENTAL (incomplete and/or non-functional), and is included for preview purposes only.) +endif + +# Common LUFA C/C++ includes/definitions +LUFA_CXX_INCLUDES = -I. -I$(patsubst %/,%,$(LUFA_PATH))/.. +LUFA_CXX_DEFINES = -DARCH=ARCH_$(ARCH) -DBOARD=BOARD_$(BOARD) -DF_USB=$(F_USB)UL + +# LUFA specific standard build options +C_FLAGS += $(LUFA_CXX_INCLUDES) $(LUFA_CXX_DEFINES) $(LUFA_CXX_FLAGS) +CPP_FLAGS += $(LUFA_CXX_INCLUDES) $(LUFA_CXX_DEFINES) $(LUFA_CXX_FLAGS) diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/LUFA/lufa-sources.mk b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/LUFA/lufa-sources.mk new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7ca9a28dc9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/LUFA/lufa-sources.mk @@ -0,0 +1,95 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2015. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +DMBS_BUILD_MODULES += LUFA_SOURCES +DMBS_BUILD_TARGETS += +DMBS_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS += LUFA_PATH ARCH +DMBS_BUILD_OPTIONAL_VARS += +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_VARS += LUFA_SRC_USB_DEVICE LUFA_SRC_USB_HOST \ + LUFA_SRC_USB LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS_DEVICE \ + LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS_HOST LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS \ + LUFA_SRC_TEMPERATURE LUFA_SRC_SERIAL \ + LUFA_SRC_TWI LUFA_SRC_PLATFORM +DMBS_BUILD_PROVIDED_MACROS += + +SHELL = /bin/sh + +ERROR_IF_UNSET ?= $(if $(filter undefined, $(origin $(strip $(1)))), $(error Makefile $(strip $(1)) value not set)) +ERROR_IF_EMPTY ?= $(if $(strip $($(strip $(1)))), , $(error Makefile $(strip $(1)) option cannot be blank)) +ERROR_IF_NONBOOL ?= $(if $(filter Y N, $($(strip $(1)))), , $(error Makefile $(strip $(1)) option must be Y or N)) + +# Sanity check user supplied values +$(foreach MANDATORY_VAR, $(LUFA_BUILD_MANDATORY_VARS), $(call ERROR_IF_UNSET, $(MANDATORY_VAR))) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, LUFA_PATH) +$(call ERROR_IF_EMPTY, ARCH) + +# Allow LUFA_ROOT_PATH to be overridden elsewhere to support legacy LUFA makefiles +LUFA_ROOT_PATH ?= $(patsubst %/,%,$(LUFA_PATH)) + +# Construct LUFA module source variables +LUFA_SRC_USB_COMMON := $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Core/$(ARCH)/USBController_$(ARCH).c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Core/$(ARCH)/USBInterrupt_$(ARCH).c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Core/ConfigDescriptors.c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Core/Events.c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Core/USBTask.c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDParser.c \ + +LUFA_SRC_USB_HOST := $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Core/$(ARCH)/Host_$(ARCH).c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Core/$(ARCH)/Pipe_$(ARCH).c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Core/$(ARCH)/PipeStream_$(ARCH).c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Core/HostStandardReq.c \ + $(LUFA_SRC_USB_COMMON) + +LUFA_SRC_USB_DEVICE := $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Core/$(ARCH)/Device_$(ARCH).c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Core/$(ARCH)/Endpoint_$(ARCH).c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Core/$(ARCH)/EndpointStream_$(ARCH).c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Core/DeviceStandardReq.c \ + $(LUFA_SRC_USB_COMMON) + +LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS_DEVICE := $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/AudioClassDevice.c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/CDCClassDevice.c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/HIDClassDevice.c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MassStorageClassDevice.c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MIDIClassDevice.c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/PrinterClassDevice.c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/RNDISClassDevice.c \ + +LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS_HOST := $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AndroidAccessoryClassHost.c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AudioClassHost.c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/CDCClassHost.c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/HIDClassHost.c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MassStorageClassHost.c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MIDIClassHost.c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/PrinterClassHost.c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/RNDISClassHost.c \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/StillImageClassHost.c + +LUFA_SRC_USB := $(sort $(LUFA_SRC_USB_COMMON) $(LUFA_SRC_USB_HOST) $(LUFA_SRC_USB_DEVICE)) + +LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS := $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS_DEVICE) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS_HOST) + +LUFA_SRC_TEMPERATURE := $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/Board/Temperature.c + +LUFA_SRC_SERIAL := $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/Peripheral/$(ARCH)/Serial_$(ARCH).c + +LUFA_SRC_TWI := $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Drivers/Peripheral/$(ARCH)/TWI_$(ARCH).c + +ifeq ($(ARCH), UC3) + LUFA_SRC_PLATFORM := $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Platform/UC3/Exception.S \ + $(LUFA_ROOT_PATH)/Platform/UC3/InterruptManagement.c +else + LUFA_SRC_PLATFORM := +endif + +# Build a list of all available module sources +LUFA_SRC_ALL_FILES := $(LUFA_SRC_USB) \ + $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) \ + $(LUFA_SRC_TEMPERATURE) \ + $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) \ + $(LUFA_SRC_TWI) \ + $(LUFA_SRC_PLATFORM) diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_atprogram.mk b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_atprogram.mk new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..86988d1cae --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_atprogram.mk @@ -0,0 +1,10 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2015. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +DMBS_PATH := $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_avrdude.mk b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_avrdude.mk new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..649215f5a3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_avrdude.mk @@ -0,0 +1,10 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2015. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +DMBS_PATH := $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_build.mk b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_build.mk new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f7c496e183 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_build.mk @@ -0,0 +1,12 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2015. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_core.mk b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_core.mk new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..62cef9046a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_core.mk @@ -0,0 +1,10 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2015. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +DMBS_PATH := $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_cppcheck.mk b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_cppcheck.mk new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..801a4c15c5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_cppcheck.mk @@ -0,0 +1,10 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2015. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +DMBS_PATH := $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_dfu.mk b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_dfu.mk new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2100ae8f78 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_dfu.mk @@ -0,0 +1,10 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2015. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +DMBS_PATH := $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_doxygen.mk b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_doxygen.mk new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..64afd4a5ac --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_doxygen.mk @@ -0,0 +1,10 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2015. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +DMBS_PATH := $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_hid.mk b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_hid.mk new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..86ca145bfa --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_hid.mk @@ -0,0 +1,10 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2015. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +DMBS_PATH := $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_sources.mk b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_sources.mk new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..48291c7317 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Build/lufa_sources.mk @@ -0,0 +1,10 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2015. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DeviceTemplate/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DeviceTemplate/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0b44c0df28 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DeviceTemplate/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,180 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor describes the overall device + * characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size + * and the number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the + * USB host when the enumeration process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(2,0,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = 64, + + .VendorID = 0x0000, + .ProductID = 0x0000, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,2), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = 0x01, + .ProductStrIndex = 0x02, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = 1 +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 0, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t LanguageString = +{ + .Header = {.Size = USB_STRING_LEN(1), .Type = DTYPE_String}, + + .UnicodeString = {LANGUAGE_ID_ENG} +}; + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t ManufacturerString = +{ + .Header = {.Size = USB_STRING_LEN(14), .Type = DTYPE_String}, + + .UnicodeString = L"Your Name Here" +}; + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t ProductString = +{ + .Header = {.Size = USB_STRING_LEN(15), .Type = DTYPE_String}, + + .UnicodeString = L"LUFA USB Device" +}; + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress + #if defined(HAS_MULTIPLE_DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS_SPACES) + , uint8_t* const DescriptorMemorySpace + #endif + ) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case 0x00: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case 0x01: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case 0x02: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + #if defined(HAS_MULTIPLE_DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS_SPACES) + *DescriptorMemorySpace = MEMSPACE_RAM; + #endif + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DeviceTemplate/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DeviceTemplate/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2bf6a6a346 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DeviceTemplate/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,59 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Macros: */ + #if (defined(ARCH_HAS_MULTI_ADDRESS_SPACE) && \ + !(defined(USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS) || defined(USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS) || defined(USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS))) + #define HAS_MULTIPLE_DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS_SPACES + #endif + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DeviceTemplate/DeviceApplication.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DeviceTemplate/DeviceApplication.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2bc44b492c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DeviceTemplate/DeviceApplication.c @@ -0,0 +1,106 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the USB device application. This file contains the + * main tasks of the application and is responsible for the initial + * application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "DeviceApplication.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + USB_Init(USB_MODE_Device, USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL); + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + /* Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to 32MHz and switch the CPU core to run from it */ + XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + + /* Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to 48MHz using the USB SOF as a reference */ + XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + + PMIC.CTRL = PMIC_LOLVLEN_bm | PMIC_MEDLVLEN_bm | PMIC_HILVLEN_bm; + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + USB_Init(USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC | USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH); + #endif +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DeviceTemplate/DeviceApplication.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DeviceTemplate/DeviceApplication.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b3429099af --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DeviceTemplate/DeviceApplication.h @@ -0,0 +1,53 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for DeviceApplication.c. + */ + +#ifndef _USB_DEVICE_APPLICATION_H_ +#define _USB_DEVICE_APPLICATION_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DeviceTemplate/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DeviceTemplate/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fd65db283f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DeviceTemplate/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,55 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="USB Device Template" id="lufa.templates.device.project.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.templates.device"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8_template"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="usbkey"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="8000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="8000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <project caption="USB Device Template" id="lufa.templates.device.project.xmega">
+ <require idref="lufa.templates.device"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8_template"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega256a3bu"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="a3bu_xplained"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="32000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="48000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.templates.device" caption="USB Device Template">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Template for a LUFA USB device mode application.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="Template Projects"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="DeviceApplication.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="DeviceApplication.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="../LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DriverStubs/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DriverStubs/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9dce2f5907 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DriverStubs/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Custom Board Hardware Information Driver (Template) + * + * This is a stub driver header file, for implementing custom board + * layout hardware with compatible LUFA board specific drivers. If + * the library is configured to use the BOARD_USER board mode, this + * driver file should be completed and copied into the "/Board/" folder + * inside the application's folder. + * + * This stub is for the board-specific component of the LUFA Board Hardware + * information driver. + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_USER_H__ +#define __BOARD_USER_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + // TODO: Add any required includes here + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted if defined. */ +// #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Dataflash mounted if defined. */ +// #define BOARD_HAS_DATAFLASH + + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Joystick mounted if defined. */ +// #define BOARD_HAS_JOYSTICK + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted if defined. */ +// #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DriverStubs/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DriverStubs/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fd74652c91 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DriverStubs/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,90 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Custom Board Button Hardware Driver (Template) + * + * This is a stub driver header file, for implementing custom board + * layout hardware with compatible LUFA board specific drivers. If + * the library is configured to use the BOARD_USER board mode, this + * driver file should be completed and copied into the "/Board/" folder + * inside the application's folder. + * + * This stub is for the board-specific component of the LUFA Buttons driver, + * for the control of physical board-mounted GPIO pushbuttons. + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_USER_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_USER_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + // TODO: Add any required includes here + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 // TODO: Add mask for first board button here + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + // TODO: Initialize the appropriate port pins as an inputs here, with pull-ups + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + // TODO: Clear the appropriate port pins as high impedance inputs here + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + // TODO: Return current button status here, debounced if required + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DriverStubs/Dataflash.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DriverStubs/Dataflash.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f405a80d52 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DriverStubs/Dataflash.h @@ -0,0 +1,223 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Custom Board Dataflash Hardware Driver (Template) + * + * This is a stub driver header file, for implementing custom board + * layout hardware with compatible LUFA board specific drivers. If + * the library is configured to use the BOARD_USER board mode, this + * driver file should be completed and copied into the "/Board/" folder + * inside the application's folder. + * + * This stub is for the board-specific component of the LUFA Dataflash + * driver. +*/ + +#ifndef __DATAFLASH_USER_H__ +#define __DATAFLASH_USER_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + // TODO: Add any required includes here + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_DATAFLASH_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK // TODO: Replace this with a mask of all the /CS pins of all Dataflashes + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_DDR // TODO: Replace with the DDR register name for the board's Dataflash ICs + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT // TODO: Replace with the PORT register name for the board's Dataflash ICs + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Constant indicating the total number of dataflash ICs mounted on the selected board. */ + #define DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS 1 // TODO: Replace with the number of Dataflashes on the board, max 2 + + /** Mask for no dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP 0 + + /** Mask for the first dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIP1 // TODO: Replace with mask with the pin attached to the first Dataflash /CS set + + /** Mask for the second dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIP2 // TODO: Replace with mask with the pin attached to the second Dataflash /CS set + + /** Internal main memory page size for the board's dataflash ICs. */ + #define DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE // TODO: Replace with the page size for the Dataflash ICs + + /** Total number of pages inside each of the board's dataflash ICs. */ + #define DATAFLASH_PAGES // TODO: Replace with the total number of pages inside one of the Dataflash ICs + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Initializes the dataflash driver so that commands and data may be sent to an attached dataflash IC. + * The microcontroller's SPI driver MUST be initialized before any of the dataflash commands are used. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_Init(void) + { + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_DDR |= DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK; + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT |= DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK; + } + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns a byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + // TODO + } + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and ignores the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + // TODO + } + + /** Sends a dummy byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) + { + // TODO + } + + /** Determines the currently selected dataflash chip. + * + * \return Mask of the currently selected Dataflash chip, either \ref DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP if no chip is selected + * or a DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is the chip number). + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) + { + return (~DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT & DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK); + } + + /** Selects the given dataflash chip. + * + * \param[in] ChipMask Mask of the Dataflash IC to select, in the form of a \c DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is + * the chip number). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) + { + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT = ((DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT | DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK) & ~ChipMask); + } + + /** Deselects the current dataflash chip, so that no dataflash is selected. */ + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) + { + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP); + } + + /** Selects a dataflash IC from the given page number, which should range from 0 to + * ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). For boards containing only one + * dataflash IC, this will select DATAFLASH_CHIP1. If the given page number is outside + * the total number of pages contained in the boards dataflash ICs, all dataflash ICs + * are deselected. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Address of the page to manipulate, ranging from + * 0 to ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(const uint16_t PageAddress) + { + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + if (PageAddress >= (DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS)) + return; + + #if (DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS == 2) + if (PageAddress & 0x01) + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP2); + else + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + #else + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + #endif + } + + /** Toggles the select line of the currently selected dataflash IC, so that it is ready to receive + * a new command. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(void) + { + uint8_t SelectedChipMask = Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(); + + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + Dataflash_SelectChip(SelectedChipMask); + } + + /** Spin-loops while the currently selected dataflash is busy executing a command, such as a main + * memory page program or main memory to buffer transfer. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(void) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + while (!(Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_READY)); + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + } + + /** Sends a set of page and buffer address bytes to the currently selected dataflash IC, for use with + * dataflash commands which require a complete 24-bit address. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Page address within the selected dataflash IC + * \param[in] BufferByte Address within the dataflash's buffer + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(uint16_t PageAddress, + const uint16_t BufferByte) + { + #if (DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS == 2) + PageAddress >>= 1; + #endif + + Dataflash_SendByte(PageAddress >> 5); + Dataflash_SendByte((PageAddress << 3) | (BufferByte >> 8)); + Dataflash_SendByte(BufferByte); + } + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DriverStubs/Joystick.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DriverStubs/Joystick.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bf17c43c4c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DriverStubs/Joystick.h @@ -0,0 +1,102 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Custom Board Joystick Hardware Driver (Template) + * + * This is a stub driver header file, for implementing custom board + * layout hardware with compatible LUFA board specific drivers. If + * the library is configured to use the BOARD_USER board mode, this + * driver file should be completed and copied into the "/Board/" folder + * inside the application's folder. + * + * This stub is for the board-specific component of the LUFA Joystick + * driver, for a digital four-way (plus button) joystick. +*/ + +#ifndef __JOYSTICK_USER_H__ +#define __JOYSTICK_USER_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + // TODO: Add any required includes here + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_JOYSTICK_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the left direction. */ + #define JOY_LEFT // TODO: Add mask to indicate joystick left position here + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the right direction. */ + #define JOY_RIGHT // TODO: Add mask to indicate joystick right position here + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the upward direction. */ + #define JOY_UP // TODO: Add mask to indicate joystick up position here + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the downward direction. */ + #define JOY_DOWN // TODO: Add mask to indicate joystick down position here + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed inward. */ + #define JOY_PRESS // TODO: Add mask to indicate joystick pressed position here + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Joystick_Init(void) + { + // TODO: Initialize joystick port pins as inputs with pull-ups + } + + static inline void Joystick_Disable(void) + { + // TODO: Clear the joystick pins as high impedance inputs here + } + + static inline uint8_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) + { + // TODO: Return current joystick position data which can be obtained by masking against the JOY_* macros + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DriverStubs/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DriverStubs/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d7d2f50236 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/DriverStubs/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,130 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Custom Board LED Hardware Driver (Template) + * + * This is a stub driver header file, for implementing custom board + * layout hardware with compatible LUFA board specific drivers. If + * the library is configured to use the BOARD_USER board mode, this + * driver file should be completed and copied into the "/Board/" folder + * inside the application's folder. + * + * This stub is for the board-specific component of the LUFA LEDs driver, + * for the LEDs (up to four) mounted on most development boards. +*/ + +#ifndef __LEDS_USER_H__ +#define __LEDS_USER_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + // TODO: Add any required includes here + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 // TODO: Add mask for first board LED here + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 // TODO: Add mask for second board LED here + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 // TODO: Add mask for third board LED here + + /** LED mask for the fourth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED4 // TODO: Add mask for fourth board LED here + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + // TODO: Add code to initialize LED port pins as outputs here + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + // TODO: Clear the LED port pins as high impedance inputs here + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + // TODO: Add code to turn on LEDs given in the LEDMask mask here, leave others as-is + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + // TODO: Add code to turn off LEDs given in the LEDMask mask here, leave others as-is + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + // TODO: Add code to turn on only LEDs given in the LEDMask mask here, all others off + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + // TODO: Add code to set the Leds in the given LEDMask to the status given in ActiveMask here + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + // TODO: Add code to toggle the Leds in the given LEDMask, ignoring all others + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + // TODO: Add code to return the current LEDs status' here which can be masked against LED_LED* macros + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/HostTemplate/HostApplication.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/HostTemplate/HostApplication.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e0774b3cd3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/HostTemplate/HostApplication.c @@ -0,0 +1,133 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the USB host application. This file contains the + * main tasks of the application and is responsible for the initial + * application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "HostApplication.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + USB_Init(USB_MODE_Host, USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize; + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData, + sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData)) != HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful) + { + return; + } + + if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + return; + } +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + +} + +/* Required callback for retrieving descriptors from a LUFA device - unless the USB_HOST_ONLY configuration + * option is set, this is still required even in an application that uses host mode only. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress +#if defined(HAS_MULTIPLE_DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS_SPACES) + , uint8_t* const DescriptorMemorySpace +#endif +) +{ + return 0; +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/HostTemplate/HostApplication.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/HostTemplate/HostApplication.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..31eea287ca --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/HostTemplate/HostApplication.h @@ -0,0 +1,56 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for HostApplication.c. + */ + +#ifndef _USB_HOST_APPLICATION_H_ +#define _USB_HOST_APPLICATION_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Macros: */ + #if (defined(ARCH_HAS_MULTI_ADDRESS_SPACE) && \ + !(defined(USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS) || defined(USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS) || defined(USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS))) + #define HAS_MULTIPLE_DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS_SPACES + #endif + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/HostTemplate/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/HostTemplate/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c1996ec711 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/HostTemplate/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="USB Host Template" id="lufa.templates.host.project">
+ <require idref="lufa.templates.host"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8_template"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="usbkey"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="8000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="8000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.templates.host" caption="USB Host Template">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Template for a LUFA USB host mode application.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="Template Projects"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="HostApplication.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="HostApplication.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="../LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bf6ee37e2e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,167 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File (Template) + * + * This is a header file which can be used to configure LUFA's + * compile time options, as an alternative to the compile time + * constants supplied through a makefile. To use this configuration + * header, copy this into your project's root directory and supply + * the \c USE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER token to the compiler so that it is + * defined in all compiled source files. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef __LUFA_CONFIG_H__ +#define __LUFA_CONFIG_H__ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG +// #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG +// #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/WindowsINF/LUFA CDC-ACM.inf b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/WindowsINF/LUFA CDC-ACM.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..212b5bbcb3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/WindowsINF/LUFA CDC-ACM.inf @@ -0,0 +1,64 @@ +; Windows LUFA CDC ACM Setup File +; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation + +[DefaultInstall] +CopyINF="LUFA CDC-ACM.inf" + +[Version] +Signature="$Windows NT$" +Class=Ports +ClassGuid={4D36E978-E325-11CE-BFC1-08002BE10318} +Provider=%MFGNAME% +DriverVer=7/1/2012,10.0.0.0 + +[Manufacturer] +%MFGNAME%=DeviceList, NTx86, NTamd64, NTia64 + +[SourceDisksNames] + +[SourceDisksFiles] + +[DestinationDirs] +DefaultDestDir=12 + +[DriverInstall] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +CopyFiles=FakeModemCopyFileSection +AddReg=DriverInstall.AddReg + +[DriverInstall.Services] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +AddService=usbser, 0x00000002, LowerFilter_Service_Inst + +[DriverInstall.AddReg] +HKR,,EnumPropPages32,,"msports.dll,SerialPortPropPageProvider" + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; Vendor and Product ID Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; When developing your USB device, the VID and PID used in the PC side +; application program and the firmware on the microcontroller must match. +; Modify the below line to use your VID and PID. Use the format as shown below. +; Note: One INF file can be used for multiple devices with different VID and PIDs. +; For each supported device, append ",USB\VID_xxxx&PID_yyyy" to the end of the line. +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[DeviceList] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2044 + +[DeviceList.NTx86] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2044 + +[DeviceList.NTamd64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2044 + +[DeviceList.NTia64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2044 + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; String Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +;Modify these strings to customize your device +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[Strings] +MFGNAME="http://www.lufa-lib.org" +DESCRIPTION="LUFA CDC-ACM Virtual Serial Port" diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/WindowsINF/LUFA RNDIS.inf b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/WindowsINF/LUFA RNDIS.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..73ca50e687 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/WindowsINF/LUFA RNDIS.inf @@ -0,0 +1,59 @@ +; Windows LUFA RNDIS Setup File +; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation + +[DefaultInstall] +CopyINF="LUFA RNDIS.inf" + +[Version] +Signature="$Windows NT$" +Class=Net +ClassGuid={4d36e972-e325-11ce-bfc1-08002be10318} +Provider=%MFGNAME% +DriverVer=7/1/2012,10.0.0.0 + +[Manufacturer] +%MFGNAME%=DeviceList, NTx86, NTamd64, NTia64 + +[ControlFlags] +ExcludeFromSelect=* + +[DriverInstall] +Characteristics=0x84 ; NCF_PHYSICAL + NCF_HAS_UI +BusType=15 +include=netrndis.inf +needs=Usb_Rndis.ndi +AddReg=Rndis_AddReg_Vista + +[DriverInstall.Services] +include=netrndis.inf +needs=Usb_Rndis.ndi.Services + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; Vendor and Product ID Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; When developing your USB device, the VID and PID used in the PC side +; application program and the firmware on the microcontroller must match. +; Modify the below line to use your VID and PID. Use the format as shown below. +; Note: One INF file can be used for multiple devices with different VID and PIDs. +; For each supported device, append ",USB\VID_xxxx&PID_yyyy" to the end of the line. +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[DeviceList] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204C + +[DeviceList.NTx86] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204C + +[DeviceList.NTamd64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204C + +[DeviceList.NTia64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204C + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; String Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +;Modify these strings to customize your device +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[Strings] +MFGNAME="http://www.lufa-lib.org" +DESCRIPTION="LUFA RNDIS USB Ethernet Adapter" diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/makefile_template b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/makefile_template new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..945d6fd613 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/CodeTemplates/makefile_template @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = Target +SRC = $(TARGET).c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) $(LUFA_SRC_PLATFORM) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/ArchitectureSpecific.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/ArchitectureSpecific.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..28f2900b96 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/ArchitectureSpecific.h @@ -0,0 +1,185 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Architecture specific definitions relating to specific processor architectures. + * + * \copydetails Group_ArchitectureSpecific + * + * \note Do not include this file directly, rather include the Common.h header file instead to gain this file's + * functionality. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Common + * \defgroup Group_ArchitectureSpecific Architecture Specific Definitions + * \brief Architecture specific definitions relating to specific processor architectures. + * + * Architecture specific macros, functions and other definitions, which relate to specific architectures. This + * definitions may or may not be available in some form on other architectures, and thus should be protected by + * preprocessor checks in portable code to prevent compile errors. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LUFA_ARCHSPEC_H__ +#define __LUFA_ARCHSPEC_H__ + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_COMMON_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Common/Common.h instead to gain this functionality. + #endif + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) || (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Re-enables the AVR's JTAG bus in software, until a system reset. This will re-enable JTAG debugging + * interface after is has been disabled in software via \ref JTAG_DISABLE(). + * + * \note This macro is not available for all architectures. + */ + #define JTAG_ENABLE() do { \ + __asm__ __volatile__ ( \ + "in __tmp_reg__,__SREG__" "\n\t" \ + "cli" "\n\t" \ + "out %1, %0" "\n\t" \ + "out __SREG__, __tmp_reg__" "\n\t" \ + "out %1, %0" "\n\t" \ + : \ + : "r" (MCUCR & ~(1 << JTD)), \ + "M" (_SFR_IO_ADDR(MCUCR)) \ + : "r0"); \ + } while (0) + + /** Disables the AVR's JTAG bus in software, until a system reset. This will override the current JTAG + * status as set by the JTAGEN fuse, disabling JTAG debugging and reverting the JTAG pins back to GPIO + * mode. + * + * \note This macro is not available for all architectures. + */ + #define JTAG_DISABLE() do { \ + __asm__ __volatile__ ( \ + "in __tmp_reg__,__SREG__" "\n\t" \ + "cli" "\n\t" \ + "out %1, %0" "\n\t" \ + "out __SREG__, __tmp_reg__" "\n\t" \ + "out %1, %0" "\n\t" \ + : \ + : "r" (MCUCR | (1 << JTD)), \ + "M" (_SFR_IO_ADDR(MCUCR)) \ + : "r0"); \ + } while (0) + #endif + + /** Defines a volatile \c NOP statement which cannot be optimized out by the compiler, and thus can always + * be set as a breakpoint in the resulting code. Useful for debugging purposes, where the optimizer + * removes/reorders code to the point where break points cannot reliably be set. + * + * \note This macro is not available for all architectures. + */ + #define JTAG_DEBUG_POINT() __asm__ __volatile__ ("nop" ::) + + /** Defines an explicit JTAG break point in the resulting binary via the assembly \c BREAK statement. When + * a JTAG is used, this causes the program execution to halt when reached until manually resumed. + * + * \note This macro is not available for all architectures. + */ + #define JTAG_DEBUG_BREAK() __asm__ __volatile__ ("break" ::) + + /** Macro for testing condition "x" and breaking via \ref JTAG_DEBUG_BREAK() if the condition is false. + * + * \note This macro is not available for all architectures. + * + * \param[in] Condition Condition that will be evaluated. + */ + #define JTAG_ASSERT(Condition) do { \ + if (!(Condition)) \ + JTAG_DEBUG_BREAK(); \ + } while (0) + + /** Macro for testing condition \c "x" and writing debug data to the stdout stream if \c false. The stdout stream + * must be pre-initialized before this macro is run and linked to an output device, such as the microcontroller's + * USART peripheral. + * + * The output takes the form "{FILENAME}: Function {FUNCTION NAME}, Line {LINE NUMBER}: Assertion {Condition} failed." + * + * \note This macro is not available for all architectures. + * + * \param[in] Condition Condition that will be evaluated, + */ + #define STDOUT_ASSERT(Condition) do { \ + if (!(Condition)) \ + printf_P(PSTR("%s: Function \"%s\", Line %d: " \ + "Assertion \"%s\" failed.\r\n"), \ + __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__, #Condition); \ + } while (0) + + #if !defined(pgm_read_ptr) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Reads a pointer out of PROGMEM space on the AVR8 architecture. This is a wrapper for the avr-libc + * \c pgm_read_word() macro with a \c void* cast, so that its value can be assigned directly to a + * pointer variable or used in pointer arithmetic without further casting in C. + * + * \note This macro is not available for all architectures. + * + * \param[in] Address Address of the pointer to read. + * + * \return Pointer retrieved from PROGMEM space. + */ + #define pgm_read_ptr(Address) (void*)pgm_read_word(Address) + #endif + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + #define JTAG_DEBUG_POINT() __asm__ __volatile__ ("nop" ::) + #define JTAG_DEBUG_BREAK() __asm__ __volatile__ ("breakpoint" ::) + #define JTAG_ASSERT(Condition) do { \ + if (!(Condition)) \ + JTAG_DEBUG_BREAK(); \ + } while (0) + #define STDOUT_ASSERT(Condition) do { \ + if (!(Condition)) \ + printf("%s: Function \"%s\", Line %d: " \ + "Assertion \"%s\" failed.\r\n", \ + __FILE__, __func__, __LINE__, #Condition); \ + } while (0) + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/Architectures.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/Architectures.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..587367413e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/Architectures.h @@ -0,0 +1,84 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Supported library architecture defines. + * + * \copydetails Group_Architectures + * + * \note Do not include this file directly, rather include the Common.h header file instead to gain this file's + * functionality. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Common + * \defgroup Group_Architectures Hardware Architectures + * \brief Supported library architecture defines. + * + * Architecture macros for selecting the desired target microcontroller architecture. One of these values should be + * defined as the value of \c ARCH in the user project makefile via the \c -D compiler switch to GCC, to select the + * target architecture. + * + * The selected architecture should remain consistent with the makefile \c ARCH value, which is used to select the + * underlying driver source files for each architecture. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LUFA_ARCHITECTURES_H__ +#define __LUFA_ARCHITECTURES_H__ + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_COMMON_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Common/Common.h instead to gain this functionality. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Selects the Atmel 8-bit AVR (AT90USB* and ATMEGA*U* chips) architecture. */ + #define ARCH_AVR8 0 + + /** Selects the Atmel 32-bit UC3 AVR (AT32UC3* chips) architecture. */ + #define ARCH_UC3 1 + + /** Selects the Atmel XMEGA AVR (ATXMEGA* chips) architecture. */ + #define ARCH_XMEGA 2 + + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #define ARCH_ ARCH_AVR8 + + #if !defined(ARCH) + #define ARCH ARCH_AVR8 + #endif + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/Attributes.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/Attributes.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c8e4104d72 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/Attributes.h @@ -0,0 +1,150 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Special function/variable attribute macros. + * + * \copydetails Group_FuncVarAttributes + * + * \note Do not include this file directly, rather include the Common.h header file instead to gain this file's + * functionality. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Common + * \defgroup Group_FuncVarAttributes Function/Variable Attributes + * \brief Special function/variable attribute macros. + * + * This module contains macros for applying specific attributes to functions and variables to control various + * optimizer and code generation features of the compiler. Attributes may be placed in the function prototype + * or variable declaration in any order, and multiple attributes can be specified for a single item via a space + * separated list. + * + * On incompatible versions of GCC or on other compilers, these macros evaluate to nothing unless they are + * critical to the code's function and thus must throw a compile error when used. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LUFA_ATTR_H__ +#define __LUFA_ATTR_H__ + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_COMMON_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Common/Common.h instead to gain this functionality. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + #if (__GNUC__ >= 3) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Indicates to the compiler that the function can not ever return, so that any stack restoring or + * return code may be omitted by the compiler in the resulting binary. + */ + #define ATTR_NO_RETURN __attribute__ ((noreturn)) + + /** Indicates that the function returns a value which should not be ignored by the user code. When + * applied, any ignored return value from calling the function will produce a compiler warning. + */ + #define ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT __attribute__ ((warn_unused_result)) + + /** Indicates that the specified parameters of the function are pointers which should never be \c NULL. + * When applied as a 1-based comma separated list the compiler will emit a warning if the specified + * parameters are known at compiler time to be \c NULL at the point of calling the function. + */ + #define ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(...) __attribute__ ((nonnull (__VA_ARGS__))) + + /** Removes any preamble or postamble from the function. When used, the function will not have any + * register or stack saving code. This should be used with caution, and when used the programmer + * is responsible for maintaining stack and register integrity. + */ + #define ATTR_NAKED __attribute__ ((naked)) + + /** Prevents the compiler from considering a specified function for in-lining. When applied, the given + * function will not be in-lined under any circumstances. + */ + #define ATTR_NO_INLINE __attribute__ ((noinline)) + + /** Forces the compiler to inline the specified function. When applied, the given function will be + * in-lined under all circumstances. + */ + #define ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE __attribute__ ((always_inline)) + + /** Indicates that the specified function is pure, in that it has no side-effects other than global + * or parameter variable access. + */ + #define ATTR_PURE __attribute__ ((pure)) + + /** Indicates that the specified function is constant, in that it has no side effects other than + * parameter access. + */ + #define ATTR_CONST __attribute__ ((const)) + + /** Marks a given function as deprecated, which produces a warning if the function is called. */ + #define ATTR_DEPRECATED __attribute__ ((deprecated)) + + /** Marks a function as a weak reference, which can be overridden by other functions with an + * identical name (in which case the weak reference is discarded at link time). + */ + #define ATTR_WEAK __attribute__ ((weak)) + #endif + + /** Forces the compiler to not automatically zero the given global variable on startup, so that the + * current RAM contents is retained. Under most conditions this value will be random due to the + * behavior of volatile memory once power is removed, but may be used in some specific circumstances, + * like the passing of values back after a system watchdog reset. + */ + #define ATTR_NO_INIT __attribute__ ((section (".noinit"))) + + /** Places the function in one of the initialization sections, which execute before the main function + * of the application. Refer to the avr-libc manual for more information on the initialization sections. + * + * \param[in] SectionIndex Initialization section number where the function should be placed. + */ + #define ATTR_INIT_SECTION(SectionIndex) __attribute__ ((used, naked, section (".init" #SectionIndex ))) + + /** Marks a function as an alias for another function. + * + * \param[in] Func Name of the function which the given function name should alias. + */ + #define ATTR_ALIAS(Func) __attribute__ ((alias( #Func ))) + + /** Marks a variable or struct element for packing into the smallest space available, omitting any + * alignment bytes usually added between fields to optimize field accesses. + */ + #define ATTR_PACKED __attribute__ ((packed)) + + /** Indicates the minimum alignment in bytes for a variable or struct element. + * + * \param[in] Bytes Minimum number of bytes the item should be aligned to. + */ + #define ATTR_ALIGNED(Bytes) __attribute__ ((aligned(Bytes))) +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/BoardTypes.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/BoardTypes.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e945523427 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/BoardTypes.h @@ -0,0 +1,263 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Supported pre-made board hardware defines. + * + * \copydetails Group_BoardTypes + * + * \note Do not include this file directly, rather include the Common.h header file instead to gain this file's + * functionality. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Common + * \defgroup Group_BoardTypes Board Types + * \brief Supported pre-made board hardware defines. + * + * Board macros for indicating the chosen physical board hardware to the library. These macros should be used when + * defining the \c BOARD token to the chosen hardware via the \c -D switch in the project makefile. If a custom + * board is used, the \ref BOARD_NONE or \ref BOARD_USER values should be selected. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LUFA_BOARDTYPES_H__ +#define __LUFA_BOARDTYPES_H__ + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_COMMON_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Common/Common.h instead to gain this functionality. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Selects the user-defined board drivers, which should be placed in the user project's folder + * under a directory named \c /Board/. Each board driver should be named identically to the LUFA + * master board driver (i.e., driver in the \c LUFA/Drivers/Board directory) so that the library + * can correctly identify it. + */ + #define BOARD_USER 0 + + /** Disables board drivers when operation will not be adversely affected (e.g. LEDs) - use of board drivers + * such as the Joystick driver, where the removal would adversely affect the code's operation is still disallowed. */ + #define BOARD_NONE 1 + + /** Selects the USBKEY specific board drivers, including Temperature, Button, Dataflash, Joystick and LED drivers. */ + #define BOARD_USBKEY 2 + + /** Selects the STK525 specific board drivers, including Temperature, Button, Dataflash, Joystick and LED drivers. */ + #define BOARD_STK525 3 + + /** Selects the STK526 specific board drivers, including Temperature, Button, Dataflash, Joystick and LED drivers. */ + #define BOARD_STK526 4 + + /** Selects the RZUSBSTICK specific board drivers, including the driver for the boards LEDs. */ + #define BOARD_RZUSBSTICK 5 + + /** Selects the ATAVRUSBRF01 specific board drivers, including the driver for the board LEDs. */ + #define BOARD_ATAVRUSBRF01 6 + + /** Selects the BUMBLEB specific board drivers, using the officially recommended peripheral layout. */ + #define BOARD_BUMBLEB 7 + + /** Selects the XPLAIN (Revision 2 or newer) specific board drivers, including LED and Dataflash drivers. */ + #define BOARD_XPLAIN 8 + + /** Selects the XPLAIN (Revision 1) specific board drivers, including LED and Dataflash drivers. */ + #define BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1 9 + + /** Selects the EVK527 specific board drivers, including Temperature, Button, Dataflash, Joystick and LED drivers. */ + #define BOARD_EVK527 10 + + /** Selects the Teensy version 1.x specific board drivers, including the driver for the board LEDs. */ + #define BOARD_TEENSY 11 + + /** Selects the USBTINY MKII specific board drivers, including the Button and LEDs drivers. */ + #define BOARD_USBTINYMKII 12 + + /** Selects the Benito specific board drivers, including the Button and LEDs drivers. */ + #define BOARD_BENITO 13 + + /** Selects the JM-DB-U2 specific board drivers, including the Button and LEDs drivers. */ + #define BOARD_JMDBU2 14 + + /** Selects the Olimex AVR-USB-162 specific board drivers, including the Button and LEDs drivers. */ + #define BOARD_OLIMEX162 15 + + /** Selects the UDIP specific board drivers, including the Button and LEDs drivers. */ + #define BOARD_UDIP 16 + + /** Selects the BUI specific board drivers, including the driver for the board LEDs. */ + #define BOARD_BUI 17 + + /** Selects the Arduino Uno specific board drivers, including the driver for the board LEDs. */ + #define BOARD_UNO 18 + + /** Selects the Busware CUL V3 specific board drivers, including the Button and LEDs drivers. */ + #define BOARD_CULV3 19 + + /** Selects the Blackcat USB JTAG specific board drivers, including the driver for the board LEDs. */ + #define BOARD_BLACKCAT 20 + + /** Selects the Maximus specific board drivers, including the driver for the board LEDs. */ + #define BOARD_MAXIMUS 21 + + /** Selects the Minimus specific board drivers, including the Button and LEDs drivers. */ + #define BOARD_MINIMUS 22 + + /** Selects the Adafruit U4 specific board drivers, including the Button driver. */ + #define BOARD_ADAFRUITU4 23 + + /** Selects the Microsin AVR-USB162 specific board drivers, including the Button and LEDs drivers. */ + #define BOARD_MICROSIN162 24 + + /** Selects the Kernel Concepts USBFOO specific board drivers, including the Button and LEDs drivers. */ + #define BOARD_USBFOO 25 + + /** Selects the Sparkfun ATMEGA8U2 specific board drivers, including the driver for the board LEDs. */ + #define BOARD_SPARKFUN8U2 26 + + /** Selects the Atmel EVK1101 specific board drivers, including the Button, Joystick and LED drivers. */ + #define BOARD_EVK1101 27 + + /** Selects the Busware TUL specific board drivers, including the Button and LED drivers. */ + #define BOARD_TUL 28 + + /** Selects the Atmel EVK1100 specific board drivers, including the Button, Joystick and LED drivers. */ + #define BOARD_EVK1100 29 + + /** Selects the Atmel EVK1104 specific board drivers, including the Button and LED drivers. */ + #define BOARD_EVK1104 30 + + /** Selects the Atmel XMEGA A3BU Xplained specific board drivers, including Dataflash, Button and LED drivers. */ + #define BOARD_A3BU_XPLAINED 31 + + /** Selects the Teensy version 2.x specific board drivers, including the driver for the board LEDs. */ + #define BOARD_TEENSY2 32 + + /** Selects the USB2AX version 1 and 2 specific board drivers, including the Button and LEDs drivers. */ + #define BOARD_USB2AX 33 + + /** Selects the USB2AX version 3 specific board drivers, including the Button and LEDs drivers. */ + #define BOARD_USB2AX_V3 34 + + /** Selects the Micropendous 32U2 specific board drivers, including the Button and LED drivers. */ + #define BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 35 + + /** Selects the Micropendous A specific board drivers, including the driver for the board Button. */ + #define BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_A 36 + + /** Selects the Micropendous 1 specific board drivers, including the driver for the board Button. */ + #define BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_1 37 + + /** Selects the Micropendous 2 specific board drivers, including the driver for the board Button. */ + #define BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_2 38 + + /** Selects the Micropendous 3 specific board drivers, including the driver for the board Button. */ + #define BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_3 39 + + /** Selects the Micropendous 4 specific board drivers, including the driver for the board Button. */ + #define BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_4 40 + + /** Selects the Micropendous DIP specific board drivers, including the driver for the board Button. */ + #define BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_DIP 41 + + /** Selects the Micropendous (Arduino-like) revision 1 specific board drivers, including the Button and LED drivers. */ + #define BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV1 42 + + /** Selects the Micropendous (Arduino-like) revision 2 specific board drivers, including the Button and LED drivers. */ + #define BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV2 43 + + /** Selects the XMEGA B1 Xplained specific board drivers, including the Button and LED drivers. */ + #define BOARD_B1_XPLAINED 44 + + /** Selects the Bitwizard Multio specific board drivers, including the driver for the board LEDs. */ + #define BOARD_MULTIO 45 + + /** Selects the Bitwizard Big-Multio specific board drivers, including the driver for the board LEDs. */ + #define BOARD_BIGMULTIO 46 + + /** Selects the DorkbotPDX Duce specific board drivers, including the driver for the board LEDs. */ + #define BOARD_DUCE 47 + + /** Selects the Olimex AVR-USB-32U4 specific board drivers, including the Button and LED drivers. */ + #define BOARD_OLIMEX32U4 48 + + /** Selects the Olimex AVR-USB-T32U4 specific board drivers, including the Button and LED drivers. */ + #define BOARD_OLIMEXT32U4 49 + + /** Selects the Olimex AVR-ISP-MK2 specific board drivers, including the Button and LED drivers. */ + #define BOARD_OLIMEXISPMK2 50 + + /** Selects the Arduino Leonardo specific board drivers, including the driver for the board LEDs. */ + #define BOARD_LEONARDO 51 + + /** Selects the UC3-A3 Xplained specific board drivers, including the Button and LED drivers. */ + #define BOARD_UC3A3_XPLAINED 52 + + /** Selects the USB2AX version 3.1 specific board drivers, including the Button and LEDs drivers. */ + #define BOARD_USB2AX_V31 53 + + /** Selects the Stange-ISP specific board drivers, including the Button and LEDs drivers. */ + #define BOARD_STANGE_ISP 54 + + /** Selects the XMEGA C3 XPLAINED specific board drivers, including the Button and LEDs drivers. */ + #define BOARD_C3_XPLAINED 55 + + /** Selects the U2S specific board drivers, including the Button and LEDs drivers. */ + #define BOARD_U2S 56 + + /** Selects the Arduino YUN specific board drivers, including the driver for the board LEDs. */ + #define BOARD_YUN 57 + + /** Selects the Arduino Micro specific board drivers, including the driver for the board LEDs. */ + #define BOARD_MICRO 58 + + /** Selects the Pololu A-Star Micro specific board drivers, including the driver for the board LEDs. */ + #define BOARD_POLOLUMICRO 59 + + /** Selects the Atmel Xplained-MINI specific board drivers, including the driver for the board LEDs. */ + #define BOARD_XPLAINED_MINI 60 + + /** Selects the QMK specific board drivres, including the driver for the board LEDs. */ + #define BOARD_QMK 61 + + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #define BOARD_ BOARD_NONE + + #if !defined(BOARD) + #define BOARD BOARD_NONE + #endif + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/Common.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/Common.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6864eb64ca --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/Common.h @@ -0,0 +1,393 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \dir + * \brief Common library header files. + * + * This folder contains header files which are common to all parts of the LUFA library. They may be used freely in + * user applications. + */ + +/** \file + * \brief Common library convenience headers, macros and functions. + * + * \copydetails Group_Common + */ + +/** \defgroup Group_Common Common Utility Headers - LUFA/Drivers/Common/Common.h + * \brief Common library convenience headers, macros and functions. + * + * Common utility headers containing macros, functions, enums and types which are common to all + * aspects of the library. + * + * @{ + */ + +/** \defgroup Group_GlobalInt Global Interrupt Macros + * \brief Convenience macros for the management of interrupts globally within the device. + * + * Macros and functions to create and control global interrupts within the device. + */ + +#ifndef __LUFA_COMMON_H__ +#define __LUFA_COMMON_H__ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_COMMON_H + + /* Includes: */ + #include <stdint.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + #include <string.h> + #include <stddef.h> + + #include "Architectures.h" + #include "BoardTypes.h" + #include "ArchitectureSpecific.h" + #include "CompilerSpecific.h" + #include "Attributes.h" + + #if defined(USE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER) + #include "LUFAConfig.h" + #endif + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Architecture specific utility includes: */ + #if defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Type define for an unsigned integer the same width as the selected architecture's machine register. + * This is distinct from the non-specific standard int data type, whose width is machine dependant but + * which may not reflect the actual machine register width on some targets (e.g. AVR8). + */ + typedef MACHINE_REG_t uint_reg_t; + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/eeprom.h> + #include <avr/boot.h> + #include <math.h> + #include <util/delay.h> + + typedef uint8_t uint_reg_t; + + #define ARCH_HAS_EEPROM_ADDRESS_SPACE + #define ARCH_HAS_FLASH_ADDRESS_SPACE + #define ARCH_HAS_MULTI_ADDRESS_SPACE + #define ARCH_LITTLE_ENDIAN + + #include "Endianness.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + #include <avr32/io.h> + #include <math.h> + + // === TODO: Find abstracted way to handle these === + #define PROGMEM + #define pgm_read_byte(x) *x + #define memcmp_P(...) memcmp(__VA_ARGS__) + #define memcpy_P(...) memcpy(__VA_ARGS__) + // ================================================= + + typedef uint32_t uint_reg_t; + + #define ARCH_BIG_ENDIAN + + #include "Endianness.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/eeprom.h> + #include <math.h> + #include <util/delay.h> + + typedef uint8_t uint_reg_t; + + #define ARCH_HAS_EEPROM_ADDRESS_SPACE + #define ARCH_HAS_FLASH_ADDRESS_SPACE + #define ARCH_HAS_MULTI_ADDRESS_SPACE + #define ARCH_LITTLE_ENDIAN + + #include "Endianness.h" + #else + #error Unknown device architecture specified. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + // Obsolete, retained for compatibility with user code + #define MACROS do + #define MACROE while (0) + #endif + + /** Convenience macro to determine the larger of two values. + * + * \attention This macro should only be used with operands that do not have side effects from being evaluated + * multiple times. + * + * \param[in] x First value to compare + * \param[in] y First value to compare + * + * \return The larger of the two input parameters + */ + #if !defined(MAX) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #define MAX(x, y) (((x) > (y)) ? (x) : (y)) + #endif + + /** Convenience macro to determine the smaller of two values. + * + * \attention This macro should only be used with operands that do not have side effects from being evaluated + * multiple times. + * + * \param[in] x First value to compare. + * \param[in] y First value to compare. + * + * \return The smaller of the two input parameters + */ + #if !defined(MIN) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #define MIN(x, y) (((x) < (y)) ? (x) : (y)) + #endif + + #if !defined(STRINGIFY) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Converts the given input into a string, via the C Preprocessor. This macro puts literal quotation + * marks around the input, converting the source into a string literal. + * + * \param[in] x Input to convert into a string literal. + * + * \return String version of the input. + */ + #define STRINGIFY(x) #x + + /** Converts the given input into a string after macro expansion, via the C Preprocessor. This macro puts + * literal quotation marks around the expanded input, converting the source into a string literal. + * + * \param[in] x Input to expand and convert into a string literal. + * + * \return String version of the expanded input. + */ + #define STRINGIFY_EXPANDED(x) STRINGIFY(x) + #endif + + #if !defined(CONCAT) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Concatenates the given input into a single token, via the C Preprocessor. + * + * \param[in] x First item to concatenate. + * \param[in] y Second item to concatenate. + * + * \return Concatenated version of the input. + */ + #define CONCAT(x, y) x ## y + + /** CConcatenates the given input into a single token after macro expansion, via the C Preprocessor. + * + * \param[in] x First item to concatenate. + * \param[in] y Second item to concatenate. + * + * \return Concatenated version of the expanded input. + */ + #define CONCAT_EXPANDED(x, y) CONCAT(x, y) + #endif + + #if !defined(ISR) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Macro for the definition of interrupt service routines, so that the compiler can insert the required + * prologue and epilogue code to properly manage the interrupt routine without affecting the main thread's + * state with unintentional side-effects. + * + * Interrupt handlers written using this macro may still need to be registered with the microcontroller's + * Interrupt Controller (if present) before they will properly handle incoming interrupt events. + * + * \note This macro is only supplied on some architectures, where the standard library does not include a valid + * definition. If an existing definition exists, the alternative definition here will be ignored. + * + * \ingroup Group_GlobalInt + * + * \param[in] Name Unique name of the interrupt service routine. + */ + #define ISR(Name, ...) void Name (void) __attribute__((__interrupt__)) __VA_ARGS__; void Name (void) + #endif + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Function to reverse the individual bits in a byte - i.e. bit 7 is moved to bit 0, bit 6 to bit 1, + * etc. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data whose bits are to be reversed. + * + * \return Input data with the individual bits reversed (mirrored). + */ + static inline uint8_t BitReverse(uint8_t Byte) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_CONST; + static inline uint8_t BitReverse(uint8_t Byte) + { + Byte = (((Byte & 0xF0) >> 4) | ((Byte & 0x0F) << 4)); + Byte = (((Byte & 0xCC) >> 2) | ((Byte & 0x33) << 2)); + Byte = (((Byte & 0xAA) >> 1) | ((Byte & 0x55) << 1)); + + return Byte; + } + + /** Function to perform a blocking delay for a specified number of milliseconds. The actual delay will be + * at a minimum the specified number of milliseconds, however due to loop overhead and internal calculations + * may be slightly higher. + * + * \param[in] Milliseconds Number of milliseconds to delay + */ + static inline void Delay_MS(uint16_t Milliseconds) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Delay_MS(uint16_t Milliseconds) + { + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + if (GCC_IS_COMPILE_CONST(Milliseconds)) + { + _delay_ms(Milliseconds); + } + else + { + while (Milliseconds--) + _delay_ms(1); + } + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + while (Milliseconds--) + { + __builtin_mtsr(AVR32_COUNT, 0); + while ((uint32_t)__builtin_mfsr(AVR32_COUNT) < (F_CPU / 1000)); + } + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + if (GCC_IS_COMPILE_CONST(Milliseconds)) + { + _delay_ms(Milliseconds); + } + else + { + while (Milliseconds--) + _delay_ms(1); + } + #endif + } + + /** Retrieves a mask which contains the current state of the global interrupts for the device. This + * value can be stored before altering the global interrupt enable state, before restoring the + * flag(s) back to their previous values after a critical section using \ref SetGlobalInterruptMask(). + * + * \ingroup Group_GlobalInt + * + * \return Mask containing the current Global Interrupt Enable Mask bit(s). + */ + static inline uint_reg_t GetGlobalInterruptMask(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint_reg_t GetGlobalInterruptMask(void) + { + GCC_MEMORY_BARRIER(); + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + return SREG; + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + return __builtin_mfsr(AVR32_SR); + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + return SREG; + #endif + } + + /** Sets the global interrupt enable state of the microcontroller to the mask passed into the function. + * This can be combined with \ref GetGlobalInterruptMask() to save and restore the Global Interrupt Enable + * Mask bit(s) of the device after a critical section has completed. + * + * \ingroup Group_GlobalInt + * + * \param[in] GlobalIntState Global Interrupt Enable Mask value to use + */ + static inline void SetGlobalInterruptMask(const uint_reg_t GlobalIntState) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void SetGlobalInterruptMask(const uint_reg_t GlobalIntState) + { + GCC_MEMORY_BARRIER(); + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + SREG = GlobalIntState; + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + if (GlobalIntState & AVR32_SR_GM) + __builtin_ssrf(AVR32_SR_GM_OFFSET); + else + __builtin_csrf(AVR32_SR_GM_OFFSET); + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + SREG = GlobalIntState; + #endif + + GCC_MEMORY_BARRIER(); + } + + /** Enables global interrupt handling for the device, allowing interrupts to be handled. + * + * \ingroup Group_GlobalInt + */ + static inline void GlobalInterruptEnable(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void GlobalInterruptEnable(void) + { + GCC_MEMORY_BARRIER(); + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + sei(); + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + __builtin_csrf(AVR32_SR_GM_OFFSET); + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + sei(); + #endif + + GCC_MEMORY_BARRIER(); + } + + /** Disabled global interrupt handling for the device, preventing interrupts from being handled. + * + * \ingroup Group_GlobalInt + */ + static inline void GlobalInterruptDisable(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void GlobalInterruptDisable(void) + { + GCC_MEMORY_BARRIER(); + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + cli(); + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + __builtin_ssrf(AVR32_SR_GM_OFFSET); + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + cli(); + #endif + + GCC_MEMORY_BARRIER(); + } + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/CompilerSpecific.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/CompilerSpecific.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..41e5305b1d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/CompilerSpecific.h @@ -0,0 +1,97 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Compiler specific definitions for code optimization and correctness. + * + * \copydetails Group_CompilerSpecific + * + * \note Do not include this file directly, rather include the Common.h header file instead to gain this file's + * functionality. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Common + * \defgroup Group_CompilerSpecific Compiler Specific Definitions + * \brief Compiler specific definitions for code optimization and correctness. + * + * Compiler specific definitions to expose certain compiler features which may increase the level of code optimization + * for a specific compiler, or correct certain issues that may be present such as memory barriers for use in conjunction + * with atomic variable access. + * + * Where possible, on alternative compilers, these macros will either have no effect, or default to returning a sane value + * so that they can be used in existing code without the need for extra compiler checks in the user application code. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LUFA_COMPILERSPEC_H__ +#define __LUFA_COMPILERSPEC_H__ + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_COMMON_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Common/Common.h instead to gain this functionality. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + #if defined(__GNUC__) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Forces GCC to use pointer indirection (via the device's pointer register pairs) when accessing the given + * struct pointer. In some cases GCC will emit non-optimal assembly code when accessing a structure through + * a pointer, resulting in a larger binary. When this macro is used on a (non \c const) structure pointer before + * use, it will force GCC to use pointer indirection on the elements rather than direct store and load + * instructions. + * + * \param[in, out] StructPtr Pointer to a structure which is to be forced into indirect access mode. + */ + #define GCC_FORCE_POINTER_ACCESS(StructPtr) __asm__ __volatile__("" : "=b" (StructPtr) : "0" (StructPtr)) + + /** Forces GCC to create a memory barrier, ensuring that memory accesses are not reordered past the barrier point. + * This can be used before ordering-critical operations, to ensure that the compiler does not re-order the resulting + * assembly output in an unexpected manner on sections of code that are ordering-specific. + */ + #define GCC_MEMORY_BARRIER() __asm__ __volatile__("" ::: "memory"); + + /** Determines if the specified value can be determined at compile-time to be a constant value when compiling under GCC. + * + * \param[in] x Value to check compile-time constantness of. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the given value is known to be a compile time constant, \c false otherwise. + */ + #define GCC_IS_COMPILE_CONST(x) __builtin_constant_p(x) + #else + #define GCC_FORCE_POINTER_ACCESS(StructPtr) + #define GCC_MEMORY_BARRIER() + #define GCC_IS_COMPILE_CONST(x) 0 + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/Endianness.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/Endianness.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8be9e0d699 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Common/Endianness.h @@ -0,0 +1,493 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Endianness and Byte Ordering macros and functions. + * + * \copydetails Group_Endianness + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Endianness + * \defgroup Group_ByteSwapping Byte Reordering + * \brief Macros and functions for forced byte reordering. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Endianness + * \defgroup Group_EndianConversion Endianness Conversion + * \brief Macros and functions for automatic endianness conversion. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Common + * \defgroup Group_Endianness Endianness and Byte Ordering + * \brief Convenience macros and functions relating to byte (re-)ordering + * + * Common library convenience macros and functions relating to byte (re-)ordering. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LUFA_ENDIANNESS_H__ +#define __LUFA_ENDIANNESS_H__ + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_COMMON_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Common/Common.h instead to gain this functionality. + #endif + + #if !(defined(ARCH_BIG_ENDIAN) || defined(ARCH_LITTLE_ENDIAN)) + #error ARCH_BIG_ENDIAN or ARCH_LITTLE_ENDIAN not set for the specified architecture. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Swaps the byte ordering of a 16-bit value at compile-time. Do not use this macro for swapping byte orderings + * of dynamic values computed at runtime, use \ref SwapEndian_16() instead. The result of this macro can be used + * inside struct or other variable initializers outside of a function, something that is not possible with the + * inline function variant. + * + * \hideinitializer + * + * \ingroup Group_ByteSwapping + * + * \param[in] x 16-bit value whose byte ordering is to be swapped. + * + * \return Input value with the byte ordering reversed. + */ + #define SWAPENDIAN_16(x) (uint16_t)((((x) & 0xFF00) >> 8) | (((x) & 0x00FF) << 8)) + + /** Swaps the byte ordering of a 32-bit value at compile-time. Do not use this macro for swapping byte orderings + * of dynamic values computed at runtime- use \ref SwapEndian_32() instead. The result of this macro can be used + * inside struct or other variable initializers outside of a function, something that is not possible with the + * inline function variant. + * + * \hideinitializer + * + * \ingroup Group_ByteSwapping + * + * \param[in] x 32-bit value whose byte ordering is to be swapped. + * + * \return Input value with the byte ordering reversed. + */ + #define SWAPENDIAN_32(x) (uint32_t)((((x) & 0xFF000000UL) >> 24UL) | (((x) & 0x00FF0000UL) >> 8UL) | \ + (((x) & 0x0000FF00UL) << 8UL) | (((x) & 0x000000FFUL) << 24UL)) + + #if defined(ARCH_BIG_ENDIAN) && !defined(le16_to_cpu) + #define le16_to_cpu(x) SwapEndian_16(x) + #define le32_to_cpu(x) SwapEndian_32(x) + #define be16_to_cpu(x) (x) + #define be32_to_cpu(x) (x) + #define cpu_to_le16(x) SwapEndian_16(x) + #define cpu_to_le32(x) SwapEndian_32(x) + #define cpu_to_be16(x) (x) + #define cpu_to_be32(x) (x) + #define LE16_TO_CPU(x) SWAPENDIAN_16(x) + #define LE32_TO_CPU(x) SWAPENDIAN_32(x) + #define BE16_TO_CPU(x) (x) + #define BE32_TO_CPU(x) (x) + #define CPU_TO_LE16(x) SWAPENDIAN_16(x) + #define CPU_TO_LE32(x) SWAPENDIAN_32(x) + #define CPU_TO_BE16(x) (x) + #define CPU_TO_BE32(x) (x) + #elif !defined(le16_to_cpu) + /** \name Run-time endianness conversion */ + //@{ + + /** Performs a conversion between a Little Endian encoded 16-bit piece of data and the + * Endianness of the currently selected CPU architecture. + * + * On little endian architectures, this macro does nothing. + * + * \note This macro is designed for run-time conversion of data - for compile-time endianness + * conversion, use \ref LE16_TO_CPU instead. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndianConversion + * + * \param[in] x Data to perform the endianness conversion on. + * + * \return Endian corrected version of the input value. + */ + #define le16_to_cpu(x) (x) + + /** Performs a conversion between a Little Endian encoded 32-bit piece of data and the + * Endianness of the currently selected CPU architecture. + * + * On little endian architectures, this macro does nothing. + * + * \note This macro is designed for run-time conversion of data - for compile-time endianness + * conversion, use \ref LE32_TO_CPU instead. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndianConversion + * + * \param[in] x Data to perform the endianness conversion on. + * + * \return Endian corrected version of the input value. + */ + #define le32_to_cpu(x) (x) + + /** Performs a conversion between a Big Endian encoded 16-bit piece of data and the + * Endianness of the currently selected CPU architecture. + * + * On big endian architectures, this macro does nothing. + * + * \note This macro is designed for run-time conversion of data - for compile-time endianness + * conversion, use \ref BE16_TO_CPU instead. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndianConversion + * + * \param[in] x Data to perform the endianness conversion on. + * + * \return Endian corrected version of the input value. + */ + #define be16_to_cpu(x) SwapEndian_16(x) + + /** Performs a conversion between a Big Endian encoded 32-bit piece of data and the + * Endianness of the currently selected CPU architecture. + * + * On big endian architectures, this macro does nothing. + * + * \note This macro is designed for run-time conversion of data - for compile-time endianness + * conversion, use \ref BE32_TO_CPU instead. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndianConversion + * + * \param[in] x Data to perform the endianness conversion on. + * + * \return Endian corrected version of the input value. + */ + #define be32_to_cpu(x) SwapEndian_32(x) + + /** Performs a conversion on a natively encoded 16-bit piece of data to ensure that it + * is in Little Endian format regardless of the currently selected CPU architecture. + * + * On little endian architectures, this macro does nothing. + * + * \note This macro is designed for run-time conversion of data - for compile-time endianness + * conversion, use \ref CPU_TO_LE16 instead. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndianConversion + * + * \param[in] x Data to perform the endianness conversion on. + * + * \return Endian corrected version of the input value. + */ + #define cpu_to_le16(x) (x) + + /** Performs a conversion on a natively encoded 32-bit piece of data to ensure that it + * is in Little Endian format regardless of the currently selected CPU architecture. + * + * On little endian architectures, this macro does nothing. + * + * \note This macro is designed for run-time conversion of data - for compile-time endianness + * conversion, use \ref CPU_TO_LE32 instead. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndianConversion + * + * \param[in] x Data to perform the endianness conversion on. + * + * \return Endian corrected version of the input value. + */ + #define cpu_to_le32(x) (x) + + /** Performs a conversion on a natively encoded 16-bit piece of data to ensure that it + * is in Big Endian format regardless of the currently selected CPU architecture. + * + * On big endian architectures, this macro does nothing. + * + * \note This macro is designed for run-time conversion of data - for compile-time endianness + * conversion, use \ref CPU_TO_BE16 instead. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndianConversion + * + * \param[in] x Data to perform the endianness conversion on. + * + * \return Endian corrected version of the input value. + */ + #define cpu_to_be16(x) SwapEndian_16(x) + + /** Performs a conversion on a natively encoded 32-bit piece of data to ensure that it + * is in Big Endian format regardless of the currently selected CPU architecture. + * + * On big endian architectures, this macro does nothing. + * + * \note This macro is designed for run-time conversion of data - for compile-time endianness + * conversion, use \ref CPU_TO_BE32 instead. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndianConversion + * + * \param[in] x Data to perform the endianness conversion on. + * + * \return Endian corrected version of the input value. + */ + #define cpu_to_be32(x) SwapEndian_32(x) + + //@} + + /** \name Compile-time endianness conversion */ + //@{ + + /** Performs a conversion between a Little Endian encoded 16-bit piece of data and the + * Endianness of the currently selected CPU architecture. + * + * On little endian architectures, this macro does nothing. + * + * \note This macro is designed for compile-time conversion of data - for run time endianness + * conversion, use \ref le16_to_cpu instead. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndianConversion + * + * \param[in] x Data to perform the endianness conversion on. + * + * \return Endian corrected version of the input value. + */ + #define LE16_TO_CPU(x) (x) + + /** Performs a conversion between a Little Endian encoded 32-bit piece of data and the + * Endianness of the currently selected CPU architecture. + * + * On little endian architectures, this macro does nothing. + * + * \note This macro is designed for compile-time conversion of data - for run time endianness + * conversion, use \ref le32_to_cpu instead. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndianConversion + * + * \param[in] x Data to perform the endianness conversion on. + * + * \return Endian corrected version of the input value. + */ + #define LE32_TO_CPU(x) (x) + + /** Performs a conversion between a Big Endian encoded 16-bit piece of data and the + * Endianness of the currently selected CPU architecture. + * + * On big endian architectures, this macro does nothing. + * + * \note This macro is designed for compile-time conversion of data - for run-time endianness + * conversion, use \ref be16_to_cpu instead. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndianConversion + * + * \param[in] x Data to perform the endianness conversion on. + * + * \return Endian corrected version of the input value. + */ + #define BE16_TO_CPU(x) SWAPENDIAN_16(x) + + /** Performs a conversion between a Big Endian encoded 32-bit piece of data and the + * Endianness of the currently selected CPU architecture. + * + * On big endian architectures, this macro does nothing. + * + * \note This macro is designed for compile-time conversion of data - for run-time endianness + * conversion, use \ref be32_to_cpu instead. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndianConversion + * + * \param[in] x Data to perform the endianness conversion on. + * + * \return Endian corrected version of the input value. + */ + #define BE32_TO_CPU(x) SWAPENDIAN_32(x) + + /** Performs a conversion on a natively encoded 16-bit piece of data to ensure that it + * is in Little Endian format regardless of the currently selected CPU architecture. + * + * On little endian architectures, this macro does nothing. + * + * \note This macro is designed for compile-time conversion of data - for run-time endianness + * conversion, use \ref cpu_to_le16 instead. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndianConversion + * + * \param[in] x Data to perform the endianness conversion on. + * + * \return Endian corrected version of the input value. + */ + #define CPU_TO_LE16(x) (x) + + /** Performs a conversion on a natively encoded 32-bit piece of data to ensure that it + * is in Little Endian format regardless of the currently selected CPU architecture. + * + * On little endian architectures, this macro does nothing. + * + * \note This macro is designed for compile-time conversion of data - for run-time endianness + * conversion, use \ref cpu_to_le32 instead. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndianConversion + * + * \param[in] x Data to perform the endianness conversion on. + * + * \return Endian corrected version of the input value. + */ + #define CPU_TO_LE32(x) (x) + + /** Performs a conversion on a natively encoded 16-bit piece of data to ensure that it + * is in Big Endian format regardless of the currently selected CPU architecture. + * + * On big endian architectures, this macro does nothing. + * + * \note This macro is designed for compile-time conversion of data - for run-time endianness + * conversion, use \ref cpu_to_be16 instead. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndianConversion + * + * \param[in] x Data to perform the endianness conversion on. + * + * \return Endian corrected version of the input value. + */ + #define CPU_TO_BE16(x) SWAPENDIAN_16(x) + + /** Performs a conversion on a natively encoded 32-bit piece of data to ensure that it + * is in Big Endian format regardless of the currently selected CPU architecture. + * + * On big endian architectures, this macro does nothing. + * + * \note This macro is designed for compile-time conversion of data - for run-time endianness + * conversion, use \ref cpu_to_be32 instead. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndianConversion + * + * \param[in] x Data to perform the endianness conversion on. + * + * \return Endian corrected version of the input value. + */ + #define CPU_TO_BE32(x) SWAPENDIAN_32(x) + + //! @} + #endif + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Function to reverse the byte ordering of the individual bytes in a 16 bit value. + * + * \ingroup Group_ByteSwapping + * + * \param[in] Word Word of data whose bytes are to be swapped. + * + * \return Input data with the individual bytes reversed. + */ + static inline uint16_t SwapEndian_16(const uint16_t Word) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_CONST ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint16_t SwapEndian_16(const uint16_t Word) + { + if (GCC_IS_COMPILE_CONST(Word)) + return SWAPENDIAN_16(Word); + + uint8_t Temp; + + union + { + uint16_t Word; + uint8_t Bytes[2]; + } Data; + + Data.Word = Word; + + Temp = Data.Bytes[0]; + Data.Bytes[0] = Data.Bytes[1]; + Data.Bytes[1] = Temp; + + return Data.Word; + } + + /** Function to reverse the byte ordering of the individual bytes in a 32 bit value. + * + * \ingroup Group_ByteSwapping + * + * \param[in] DWord Double word of data whose bytes are to be swapped. + * + * \return Input data with the individual bytes reversed. + */ + static inline uint32_t SwapEndian_32(const uint32_t DWord) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_CONST ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint32_t SwapEndian_32(const uint32_t DWord) + { + if (GCC_IS_COMPILE_CONST(DWord)) + return SWAPENDIAN_32(DWord); + + uint8_t Temp; + + union + { + uint32_t DWord; + uint8_t Bytes[4]; + } Data; + + Data.DWord = DWord; + + Temp = Data.Bytes[0]; + Data.Bytes[0] = Data.Bytes[3]; + Data.Bytes[3] = Temp; + + Temp = Data.Bytes[1]; + Data.Bytes[1] = Data.Bytes[2]; + Data.Bytes[2] = Temp; + + return Data.DWord; + } + + /** Function to reverse the byte ordering of the individual bytes in a n byte value. + * + * \ingroup Group_ByteSwapping + * + * \param[in,out] Data Pointer to a number containing an even number of bytes to be reversed. + * \param[in] Length Length of the data in bytes. + * + * \return Input data with the individual bytes reversed. + */ + static inline void SwapEndian_n(void* const Data, + uint8_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void SwapEndian_n(void* const Data, + uint8_t Length) + { + uint8_t* CurrDataPos = (uint8_t*)Data; + + while (Length > 1) + { + uint8_t Temp = *CurrDataPos; + *CurrDataPos = *(CurrDataPos + Length - 1); + *(CurrDataPos + Length - 1) = Temp; + + CurrDataPos++; + Length -= 2; + } + } + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/BuildSystem.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/BuildSystem.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ef57fcf0c7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/BuildSystem.txt @@ -0,0 +1,281 @@ +/** \file
+ *
+ * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special
+ * documentation pages. It is not a project source file.
+ */
+
+/** \page Page_BuildSystem The LUFA Build System
+ *
+ * \section Sec_BuildSystem_Overview Overview of the LUFA Build System
+ * The LUFA build system was originally an attempt at making a set of
+ * re-usable, modular build make files which could be referenced in a LUFA
+ * powered project, to minimize the amount of code required in an
+ * application makefile.
+ *
+ * As it turned out to be fairly generic in nature, it was split out into its
+ * own separate project, called DMBS (<i>Dean's Makefile Build System</i>)
+ * which is released into the public domain. LUFA-specific portions of the
+ * LUFA build system extend DMBS, and provide a universal build system for all
+ * LUFA projects.
+ *
+ * The latest DMBS project information and documentation can be found at:
+ * https://github.com/abcminiuser/dmbs
+ *
+ * DMBS is written in GNU Make, and each module is independent of one-another.
+ *
+ * LUFA now uses DMBS for its build system, with some LUFA specific extension
+ * modules.
+ *
+ * If you have problems building using LUFA, see \subpage Page_BuildTroubleshooting for resolution steps.
+ *
+ * \li \subpage Page_BuildModule_LUFA_SOURCES - The LUFA SOURCES extension module for DMBS
+ * \li \subpage Page_BuildModule_LUFA_GCC - The LUFA GCC extension module for DMBS
+ */
+
+/** \page Page_BuildModule_LUFA_SOURCES LUFA SOURCES extension module for DMBS
+ *
+ * The LUFA SOURCES extension more for DMBS provides LUFA specific variables
+ * listing the various LUFA source files required to be build by a project for
+ * a given LUFA module. This module gives a way to reference LUFA source files
+ * symbolically, so that changes to the library structure do not break the
+ * library makefile.
+ *
+ * To use this module in your application makefile, add the following code:
+ * \code
+ * include $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA/lufa-sources.mk
+ * \endcode
+ *
+ * \section SSec_BuildModule_LUFA_SOURCES_Requirements Requirements
+ * None.
+ *
+ * \section SSec_BuildModule_LUFA_SOURCES_Targets Targets
+ *
+ * <table>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><i>None</i></td>
+ * </tr>
+ * </table>
+ *
+ * \section SSec_BuildModule_LUFA_SOURCES_MandatoryParams Mandatory Parameters
+ *
+ * <table>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><tt>LUFA_PATH</tt></td>
+ * <td>Path to the LUFA library core, either relative or absolute (e.g. <tt>../LUFA-000000/LUFA/</tt>).</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><tt>ARCH</tt></td>
+ * <td>Architecture of the target processor (see \ref Page_DeviceSupport).</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * </table>
+ *
+ * \section SSec_BuildModule_LUFA_SOURCES_OptionalParams Optional Parameters
+ *
+ * <table>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><i>None</i></td>
+ * </tr>
+ * </table>
+ *
+ * \section SSec_BuildModule_LUFA_SOURCES_ProvidedVariables Module Provided Variables
+ *
+ * <table>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><tt>LUFA_SRC_USB</tt></td>
+ * <td>List of LUFA USB driver source files.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><tt>LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS</tt></td>
+ * <td>List of LUFA USB Class driver source files.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><tt>LUFA_SRC_TEMPERATURE</tt></td>
+ * <td>List of LUFA temperature sensor driver source files.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><tt>LUFA_SRC_SERIAL</tt></td>
+ * <td>List of LUFA Serial U(S)ART driver source files.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><tt>LUFA_SRC_TWI</tt></td>
+ * <td>List of LUFA TWI driver source files.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><tt>LUFA_SRC_PLATFORM</tt></td>
+ * <td>List of LUFA architecture specific platform management source files.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * </table>
+ *
+ * \section SSec_BuildModule_LUFA_SOURCES_ProvidedMacros Module Provided Macros
+ *
+ * <table>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><i>None</i></td>
+ * </tr>
+ * </table>
+ */
+
+/** \page Page_BuildModule_LUFA_GCC LUFA GCC extension module for DMBS
+ *
+ * The LUFA GCC extension module for the standard DMBS GCC module extends the
+ * latter to support the compilation of LUFA powered projects. It should be
+ * imported into your LUFA powered project makefiles to ensure that the correct
+ * build settings are used for the project's configuration.
+ *
+ * To use this module in your application makefile, add the following code:
+ * \code
+ * include $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA/lufa-gcc.mk
+ * \endcode
+ *
+ * \section SSec_BuildModule_LUFA_GCC_Requirements Requirements
+ * This module should be included in your makefile *after* the DMBS GCC module.
+ *
+ * \section SSec_BuildModule_LUFA_GCC_Targets Targets
+ *
+ * <table>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><i>None</i></td>
+ * </tr>
+ * </table>
+ *
+ * \section SSec_BuildModule_LUFA_GCC_MandatoryParams Mandatory Parameters
+ *
+ * <table>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><tt>LUFA_PATH</tt></td>
+ * <td>Path to the LUFA library core, either relative or absolute (e.g. <tt>../LUFA-000000/LUFA/</tt>).</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * </table>
+ *
+ * \section SSec_BuildModule_LUFA_GCC_OptionalParams Optional Parameters
+ *
+ * <table>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><tt>BOARD</tt></td>
+ * <td>LUFA board hardware drivers to use (see \ref Page_DeviceSupport).</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * </table>
+ *
+ * \section SSec_BuildModule_LUFA_GCC_ProvidedVariables Module Provided Variables
+ *
+ * <table>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><i>None</i></td>
+ * </tr>
+ * </table>
+ *
+ * \section SSec_BuildModule_LUFA_GCC_ProvidedMacros Module Provided Macros
+ *
+ * <table>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><i>None</i></td>
+ * </tr>
+ * </table>
+ */
+
+/** \page Page_BuildTroubleshooting Troubleshooting Information
+ *
+ * LUFA uses a lot of advanced features of the AVR-GCC compiler, linker, and
+ * surrounding binaries. This can sometimes lead to problems compiling
+ * applications if one of these features is buggy in the version of the tools
+ * used in a build environment. Missing utilities and incorrectly set makefile
+ * configuration options can also result in different errors being produced
+ * when compilation or other operations are attempted. The table below lists a
+ * set of commonly encountered errors and their resolutions.
+ *
+ * <table>
+ * <tr>
+ * <th>Problem</th>
+ * <th>Resolution</th>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td>Error "<b><tt>relocation truncated to fit: R_AVR_13_PCREL against symbol <i>{X}</i></tt></b>" shown when compiling.</td>
+ * <td>Try compiling with the setting <tt>LINKER_RELAXATIONS=N</tt> in your LUFA Build System 2.0 makefile, or remove the line <tt>-Wl,--relax</tt>
+ * from other makefiles. Alternatively, make sure you have the latest version of the Atmel Toolchain installed for your system.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td>Error "<b><tt>error: ld terminated with signal 11 [Segmentation fault]</tt></b>" shown when compiling.</td>
+ * <td>Try compiling with the setting <tt>DEBUG_LEVEL=2</tt> in your LUFA Build System 2.0 makefile, or make sure you are using <tt>binutils</tt> version 2.22 or later.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td>Error "<b><tt>EMERGENCY ABORT: INFINITE RECURSION DETECTED</tt></b>" shown when compiling.</td>
+ * <td>Make sure you are using an up to date version of GNU Make when compiling. This error is a safety system added to the mid-level makefiles, to prevent an issue with
+ * GNU make or other variants of Make causing an infinitely recursive build.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td>Error "<b><tt>Unsupported architecture "<i>{X}</i>"</tt></b>" shown when compiling.</td>
+ * <td>Ensure your makefile's <tt>ARCH</tt> setting is set to one of the architecture names (case-sensitive) supported by the version of LUFA you are compiling against.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td>Error "<b><tt>Makefile <i>{X}</i> value not set</tt></b>" shown when compiling.</td>
+ * <td>The specified Makefile value was not configured in your project's makefile or on the command line, and the nominated setting is required by one or more LUFA
+ * build system modules. Define the value in your project makefile and try again.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td>Error "<b><tt>Makefile <i>{X}</i> option cannot be blank</tt></b>" shown when compiling.</td>
+ * <td>The specified Makefile value was configured in your project's makefile or on the command line, but was set to an empty value. For the nominated configuration
+ * option, an empty value is not allowed. Define the nominated setting to a correct non-blank value and try again.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td>Error "<b><tt>Makefile <i>{X}</i> option must be Y or N</tt></b>" shown when compiling.</td>
+ * <td>The specified Makefile value was configured in your project's makefile or on the command line, but was set to a value other than a Y (for "Yes") or "N" (for "No").
+ * This configuration option is required to be one of the aforementioned boolean values, and other values are invalid. Set this option to either Y or N and try again.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td>Error "<b><tt>Unknown input source file formats: <i>{X}</i></tt></b>" shown when compiling.</td>
+ * <td>The nominated source files, specified in your project's makefile in the <tt>SRC</tt> configuration option, has an extension that the LUFA build system does not
+ * recognise. The file extensions are case sensitive, and must be one of the supported formats (<tt>*.c</tt>, <tt>*.cpp</tt> or <tt>*.S</tt>).</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td>Error "<b><tt>Cannot build with OBJDIR parameter set - one or more object file name is not unique</tt></b>" shown when compiling.</td>
+ * <td>When a project is built with a non-empty <tt>OBJDIR</tt> object directory name set, all input source files must have unique names, excluding extension and path.
+ * This means that input files that are named identically and differ only by their path or extension are invalid when this mode is used.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td>Error "<b><tt>Source file does not exist: <i>{X}</i></tt></b>" shown when compiling.</td>
+ * <td>The nominated input source file, specified in the user project's <tt>SRC</tt> parameter, could not be found. Ensure the source file exists and the absolute or
+ * relative path given in the user project makefile is correct and try again.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td>Error "<b><tt>Doxygen configuration file <i>{X}</i> does not exist</tt></b>" shown when upgrading a Doxygen configuration file.</td>
+ * <td>The nominated Doxygen configuration file, specified in the user project's <tt>DOXYGEN_CONF</tt> parameter, could not be found. Ensure the configuration file exists
+ * and the absolute or relative path given in the user project makefile is correct and try again, or run the appropriate makefile target to generate a new configuration
+ * file.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td>Error "<b><tt>avr-gcc: error: unrecognized option '<i>{X}</i>'</tt></b>" shown when compiling.</td>
+ * <td>An unrecognised option was supplied to the compiler, usually in the <tt>C_FLAGS</tt>, <tt>CPP_FLAGS</tt>, <tt>ASM_FLAGS</tt> or <tt>CC_FLAGS</tt> configuration
+ * options. The nominated compiler switch may be invalid, or unsupported by the version of AVR-GCC on the host system. Remove the unrecognised flag if invalid, or
+ * upgrade to the latest AVR-GCC. If the option is a valid linker option, use the prefix "-Wl," to ensure it is passed to the linker correctly.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td>Error "<b><tt>makefile:{X}: {Y}.mk: No such file or directory</tt></b>" shown when make is invoked.</td>
+ * <td>The path to the nominated makefile module was incorrect. This usually indicates that the makefile <tt>LUFA_PATH</tt> option is not set to a valid relative or
+ * absolute path to the LUFA library core.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td>Error "<b><tt>fatal error: LUFAConfig.h: No such file or directory</tt></b>" shown when compiling.</td>
+ * <td>The <tt>USE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER</tt> compile time option was set in the user project makefile, but the user supplied <tt>LUFAConfig.h</tt> header could not be
+ * found. Ensure that the directory that contains this configuration file is correctly passed to the compiler via the -I switch in the makefile <tt>CC_FLAGS</tt>
+ * parameter.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td>Error "<b><tt>ld.exe: section .apitable_trampolines loaded at <i>{X}</i> overlaps section .text</tt></b>" shown when compiling a bootloader.</td>
+ * <td>The bootloader is compiling too large for the given <tt>FLASH_SIZE_KB</tt> and <tt>BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB</tt> parameters set in the bootloader makefile. This
+ * usually indicates that these values are incorrect for the specified device the bootloader is targeting. If these values are correct, a newer version of the
+ * compiler may need to be used to ensure that the bootloader is built within the section size constraints of the target device.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td>Error "<b><tt>unknown MCU '<i>{X}</i>' specified</tt></b>" shown when compiling.</td>
+ * <td>The specified microcontroller device model name set in the user application's makefile as the <tt>MCU</tt> parameter is incorrect, or unsupported by the
+ * version of the compiler being used. Make sure the model name is correct, or upgrade to the latest Atmel Toolchain to obtain newer device support.</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td>Error "<b><tt>undefined reference to `<i>{X}</i>'</tt></b>" shown when compiling.</td>
+ * <td>This is usually caused by a missing source file in the user application's <tt>SRC</tt> configuration parameter. If the indicated symbol is one from the LUFA
+ * library, you may be missing a LUFA source makefile module (see \ref Page_BuildModule_LUFA_SOURCES).</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * </table>
+ *
+ * For troubleshooting other errors you encounter, please see \ref Sec_ProjectHelp.
+ */
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/BuildingLinkableLibraries.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/BuildingLinkableLibraries.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cbbae4b8e9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/BuildingLinkableLibraries.txt @@ -0,0 +1,23 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \page Page_BuildLibrary Building as a Linkable Library + * + * The LUFA library can be built as a proper linkable library (with the extension .a) under AVR-GCC, so that + * the library does not need to be recompiled with each revision of a user project. Instructions for creating + * a library from a given source tree can be found in the AVR-GCC user manual included in the WinAVR install + * /Docs/ directory. + * + * However, building the library is <b>not recommended</b>, as the static (compile-time) options will be + * unable to be changed without a recompilation of the LUFA code. Therefore, if the library is to be built + * from the LUFA source, it should be made to be application-specific and compiled with the static options + * that are required for each project (which should be recorded along with the library). + * + * Normal library use has the library components compiled in at the same point as the application code, as + * demonstrated in the library demos and applications. This is the preferred method, as the library is recompiled + * each time to ensure that all static options for a particular application are applied. + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/ChangeLog.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/ChangeLog.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..aedfd3ce53 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/ChangeLog.txt @@ -0,0 +1,1653 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + + /** \page Page_ChangeLog Project Changelog + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog170418 Version 170418 + * <b>New:</b> + * - Core: + * - Added support for the Pololu A-Star Micro board (thanks to Joh Schneider) + * - Added new \c LUFA_VERSION_RELEASE_TYPE macro to the library version header, to determine release type (thanks to NicoHood) + * + * <b>Fixed:</b> + * - Core: + * - The CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor() callback function into the user application erroneously had a uint8_t type for the wIndex + * parameter, instead of uint16_t (thanks to Matlo) + * - Fixed broken USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS compile time option when the FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS compile time option is not enabled + * in a user application (thanks to Matlo) + * - Fixed missing \c va_end() calls in the HID bootloader CLI app which could cause portability issues + * - Fixed void pointer arithmetic in the \c Serial_SendData() functions for AVR8 and XMEGA architectures + * - Fixed void pointer arithmetic in the low level and class driver RNDIS demo protocol decoders + * - Fixed low level RNDIS demo incorrectly setting the RNDIS state when a null packet filter was requested + * - Fixed missing entries in several project's Atmel Studio integration files, such as driver INF files + * - Fixed invalid endpoint indexes causing memory corruption in device Clear/Set Feature standard requests (thanks to Peter Popovec) + * - Fixed incorrect serialization in USB_SetHIDReportItemInfo() function (thanks to e-chip) + * + * <b>Changed:</b> + * - Added signed alternative libUSB driver for the AVRISP-MKII clone project, to support Atmel Studio 7 (thanks to Atmel) + * - Removed no longer required LIBUSB_DRIVER_COMPAT and RESET_TOGGLES_LIBUSB_COMPAT configuration options from the AVRISP-MKII + * clone project, as the new libUSB driver works for AVRDUDE and Atmel Studio 7 under Windows + * - Replaced the LUFA build system with its (compatible) successor, DMBS (Dean's Makefile Build System) + * - Removed obsolete library TAR export and associated documentation + * - Fixed incorrect HID_DESCRIPTOR_KEYBOARD() macro definition (thanks to Eric Tang) + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog151115 Version 151115 + * <b>New:</b> + * - Added support for the Atmel Xplained-MINI series of development kits + * - Added new PROGMEM variant send functions to the CDC class device driver (thanks to Stefan Hellermann) + * - Added new PROGMEM variant send functions to the CDC class host driver + * - Added additional Arduino Uno board definitions for the main processor reset (thanks to NicoHood) + * - Added modified DocBook transforms to generate Atmel Studio 6/7 internal help documentation (thanks to Morten Engelhardt Olsen) + * + * <b>Changed:</b> + * - Core: + * - The TWI peripheral driver's TWI_WritePacket() and TWI_ReadPacket() functions now takes a 16-bit Length rather than an 8-bit + * length, for longer transfers + * - Library Applications: + * - The CDC, DFU, Mass Storage and Printer class bootloaders will no longer run the user application if the application reset + * vector is blank (thanks to Alex Kazik) + * - The CDC, DFU and Printer class bootloaders are now compatible with the original Atmel XPLAIN and Arduino Leonardo boards + * - The CDC, DFU, Mass Storage and Printer class bootloaders are not compatible with devices with the BOOTRST fuse set and will + * exit automatically unless an external reset was the last reset cause (thanks to Alex Kazik) + * - Added missing force-inline attribute to the endianness utility functions (thanks to Stefan Hellermann) + * - Updated the DFU build system module to use updated EEPROM programming command arguments for dfu-programmer 0.6.2 or newer + * + * <b>Fixed:</b> + * - Fixed broken XMEGA serial stream driver due to missing USART base pointer parameter (thanks to William Patterson) + * - Fixed incorrect signature reported in the CDC/DFU bootloaders for the AT90USB82 (thanks to NicoHood) + * - Fixed broken RNDIS demos on Linux machines whose DHCP hosts require a Lease Time option (thanks to Stefan Hellermann) + * - Fixed broken LEDs_Disable() implementation for the Arduino Uno board (thanks to NicoHood) + * - Fixed missing bounds checks and off-by-one in the DFU bootloader signature bytes (thanks to Reuti) + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog140928 Version 140928 + * <b>New:</b> + * - Core: + * - Updated the BUILD build system module to add a new COMPILER_PATH optional variable + * - Added Serial_IsSendReady() and Serial_IsSendComplete() functions to the Serial hardware peripheral driver + * - Added support for the Arduino Yun board (ATMEGA32U4 co-processor) + * - Added support for the Arduino Micro board (thanks to Zoltán Szőke) + * - Library Applications: + * - Added new Dual MIDI class driver device demo + * + * <b>Changed:</b> + * - Core: + * - The RNDIS device class driver now takes a user-supplied buffer and buffer length for the internal RNDIS + * message management (thanks to Peter Mc Shane) + * + * <b>Fixed:</b> + * - Core: + * - Fixed device class driver pipe configuration routines returning success with a partially constructed instance + * when a pipe configuration failed (thanks to Helge Suess) + * - Fixed incorrect XMEGA DFLL reference frequency (thanks to Martin Aakerberg) + * - Fixed possible infinite loop in the control endpoint stream write function (thanks to Clayton Knight) + * - Fixed missing HID report ID prefix on HID class driver GetReport request responses (thanks to Bert van Hall) + * - Fixed incorrect XMEGA USB controller clock division factory for non-Full Speed operation (thanks to Bert van Hall) + * - Fixed the LUFA build system to prevent incorrect code from being generated in newer toolchains when building for larger + * FLASH memory devices (thanks to demultiplexer) + * - Fixed missing parenthesis in the MIDI_EVENT() macro which could cause incorrect results (thanks to hexwab) + * - Fixed mixed capitalization of TWI in the XMEGA TWI driver causing compilation failures (thanks to Jacob Schloss) + * - Fixed broken AVR8 USART-SPI peripheral driver (thanks to Phil Zakielarz) + * - Library Applications: + * - Fixed spurious 0xFE USART byte sent in the USBtoSerial project when the baud rate is changed (thanks to Carl Kjeldsen) + * - Fixed blocking USART reads causing low throughput on slow baud rates in the USBtoSerial project (thanks to Nevada Smith) + * - Fixed USART reception overrun corrupting the internal buffers in the USBtoSerial project (thanks to Nevada Smith) + * - Fixed broken LowLevel Audio Out demo sampling frequency configuration (thanks to Torsten Duwe) + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog140302 Version 140302 + * <b>New:</b> + * - Library Applications: + * - Added new Bulk Vendor low level device demo + * - Added new libUSB host Python and NodeJS application examples for the Class driver GenericHID demo (thanks to Laszlo Monda) + * - Added new AVR8 USB option to keep 3.3V regulator enabled (thanks to Michael Hanselmann) + * - Added new USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR() and USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY() convenience macros (thanks to Laszlo Monda) + * + * <b>Changed:</b> + * - Library Applications: + * - Refactored out USB interface IDs in the demo applications into enums (thanks to Laszlo Monda) + * - AVRISP-MKII Clone Project PDI/TPI frequency increased from 250KHz to 2MHz as it is now stable + * - Increased TPI/PDI handshake delay to 100us from 1us to support targets with high amounts of capacitance on their + * /RESET lines (thanks to Paul Duke) + * - Changed the VERSION_BCD() macro to accept the major/minor/revision values as separate parameters + * + * <b>Fixed:</b> + * - Core: + * - Fixed MIDI device class driver MIDI_Device_ReceiveEventPacket() for the XMEGA architecture + * - Library Applications: + * - Fixed incorrect signature bytes returned in the DFU bootloader + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog130901 Version 130901 + * <b>New:</b> + * - Core: + * - Added additional MIDI command definitions to the MIDI class driver (thanks to Daniel Dreibrodt) + * - Added new CONCAT() and CONCAT_EXPANDED() convenience macros + * - Added new Printer Device Class driver + * - Added support for the XMEGA C3 Xplained board + * - Added support for the U2S board (thanks to megal0maniac) + * - Added TWI Master driver for the XMEGA architecture (thanks to Michael Janssen) + * - Library Applications: + * - Added new Printer class bootloader + * - Added new Mass Storage class bootloader + * - Added XMEGA support for class driver device demos (where applicable) + * - Added Python host application example for the Generic HID class driver device demo + * - Added Python alternative host application for the HID class bootloader + * + * <b>Changed:</b> + * - Core: + * - Updated the BUILD build system module to produce binary BIN files in addition to Intel HEX files + * - Updated the Android Accessory Class to accept version 2 protocol devices (with version 1 functionality) + * - All board drivers now implement dummy functions and constants when BOARD is set to NONE + * - Added missing LEDs to the XMEGA A3BU Xplained board LED driver (thanks to Michael Janssen) + * - Changed board Dataflash drivers to automatically configure the appropriate SPI interface for the selected board + * - Library Applications: + * - Re-added Set Control Line State request handling to the CDC class bootloader to prevent issues with the .NET serial + * class (thanks to Erik Lins) + * - TemperatureDataLogger project dummy RTC mode now tracks real time (thanks to David Lazarus) + * + * <b>Fixed:</b> + * - Core: + * - Fixed Low Speed USB devices broken when using the library HID Class driver (thanks to Michael) + * - Fixed possible register corruption in USB Host mode on AVR8 devices when ORDERED_EP_CONFIG is used (thanks to Martin Aakerberg) + * - Fixed Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress() returning invalid endpoint directions on AVR8 architecture devices (thanks to decerri) + * under some circumstances + * - Fixed incorrect USB device state set when a suspended LUFA device is woken while addressed but not configured (thanks to Balaji Krishnan) + * - Fixed broken USART SPI driver for the AVR8 architecture due to incorrect initialization + * - Fixed re-enumeration issue of XMEGA architecture targets (thanks to Jaroslav Jedlinsky) + * - Fixed error receiving PIMA events via the Still Image Host class driver + * - Library Applications: + * - Added handler for SCSI_CMD_START_STOP_UNIT in demos using the Mass Storage class, to prevent ejection errors on *nix systems due to an + * unknown SCSI command + * - Fixed incorrect HID report descriptor generated for 16-bit axis ranges by the HID_DESCRIPTOR_MOUSE() and HID_DESCRIPTOR_JOYSTICK() + * macros (thanks to Armory) + * - Fixed incorrect HID report descriptor generated for button multiples of 8 by the HID_DESCRIPTOR_MOUSE() and HID_DESCRIPTOR_JOYSTICK() + * macros + * - Fixed race condition in the DFU class bootloader causing failed device reprogramming in some circumstances (thanks to Luis Mendes) + * - Fixed incorrect time/date configuration data order in the TempDataLogger host application (thanks to David Lazarus) + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog130303 Version 130303 + * <b>New:</b> + * - Core: + * - Added support for the Arduino Leonardo board + * - Added support for the Atmel UC3-A3 Xplained board + * - Added support for the Xevelabs USB2AX revision 3.1 board + * - Added support for the Dimex Stange-ISP board (thanks to Gerhard Wesser) + * - Added new \c doxygen_upgrade and \c doxygen_create targets to the DOXYGEN build system module + * - Added new Board Hardware Information board driver + * - Library Applications: + * - Added a different device serial number when the AVRISP-MKII Clone project is in libUSB compatibility mode, so that + * both the libUSB and Jungo drivers can be installed at the same time without having to use a filter driver + * + * <b>Changed:</b> + * - Core: + * - Added workaround for broken VBUS detection on AVR8 devices when a bootloader starts the application + * via a software jump without first turning off the OTG pad (thanks to Simon Inns) + * - Library Applications: + * - Increased throughput in the USBtoSerial project now that data transmission is non-blocking (thanks to Joseph Lacerte) + * - Updated bootloader makefiles to remove dependency on the \c bc command line calculator tool + * - Updated AVRISP-MKII Clone Programmer project so that the SCK clock period is saved in EEPROM (thanks to Gerhard Wesser) + * - Changed all *_SendByte() function prototypes to accept a void pointer for the input buffer (thanks to Simon Kuppers) + * + * <b>Fixed:</b> + * - Core: + * - Fixed incorrectly issuing STALL response to unsupported control request SETUP packets, rather than in the data/status stage + * - Fixed inverted LEDs_GetLEDs() function implementation for the Benito, Minimus and Arduino UNO boards + * - Fixed missing Windows 32-bit compatibility sections in the LUFA INF driver files (thanks to Christan Beharrell) + * - Fixed logic hole breaking USB operations on a USB controller with only one supported USB mode and no USB_DEVICE_ONLY or USB_HOST_ONLY + * configuration token set + * - Fixed possible rounding in the VERSION_BCD() macros for some 0.01 step increments (thanks to Oliver Zander) + * - Fixed incorrect Dataflash functionality in the USBKEY board if the driver is modified for a single Dataflash chip (thanks to Jonathan Oakley) + * - Fixed incorrect definitions of \c HID_KEYBOARD_LED_KANA, \c HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_EQUAL_SIGN and \c HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_EQUAL_SIGN_AS400 + * and added a missing definition for \c HID_KEYBOARD_SC_APPLICATION (thanks to David Monro) + * - Fixed maximum allowed keyboard key code usage of \c 0x65 rather than \c 0xFF for the \c HID_DESCRIPTOR_KEYBOARD() macro (thanks to David Monro) + * - Fixed hardware race condition that could cause failed device enumerations for AVR8 and UC3 architectures (thanks to Mike Beyhs) + * - Fixed incorrect Minimus board LED definitions (thanks to Joonas Lahtinen) + * - Fixed incorrect ordering of the linker options in the build system causing link failures in some cases + * - Fixed bug in the TWI peripheral driver for the AVR8 devices causing incorrect failure codes to be returned in some cases (thanks to Peter K) + * - Fixed swapped LED3 and LED4 masks for the Olimex-32U4 development board LED driver + * - Fixed potential NULL pointer dereference in the HID Host mode Class Driver (thanks to Pavel Kuzmin) + * - Library Applications: + * - Fixed broken RESET_TOGGLES_LIBUSB_COMPAT compile time option in the AVRISP-MKII project + * - Fixed incompatibility in the CDC class bootloader on some systems (thanks to Sylvain Munaut) + * - Fixed lengthy timeouts in the USBtoSerial project if no application on the host is consuming data (thanks to Nicolas Saugnier) + * - Fixed lengthy automatic data flushing in the CDC and MIDI device class drivers + * - Fixed incorrect LED masks for received data display in the Device GenericHID demos (thanks to Denys Berkovskyy) + * - Fixed incorrect output in the HIDReportViewer project when no device is connected (thanks to Pavel Kuzmin) + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog120730 Version 120730 + * <b>New:</b> + * - Core: + * - Added new, revamped modular build system with new makefile templates + * - Added support for the BitWizard Multio and Big-Multio boards + * - Added support for the DorkbotPDX Duce board + * - Added support for the Olimex AVR-USB-32U4 board + * - Added support for the Olimex AVR-USB-T32U4 board + * - Added support for the Olimex AVR-ISP-MK2 board + * - Added new Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable() function + * - Added new Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable() function + * - Added build test to verify correct compilation of all board drivers using all driver APIs + * - Added build test to verify correct compilation of all bootloaders using all supported devices + * - Added build test to verify that there are no detectable errors in the codebase via static analysis + * - Added new JTAG_ENABLE() macro for the AVR8 architecture + * - Library Applications: + * - Modified the CDC Host demos to set a default CDC Line Encoding on enumerated devices + * - Added Dataflash operational checks and aborts to all projects using the Dataflash to ensure it is working correctly before use + * - Added new SerialToLCD user project contributed by Simon Foster + * - Added new RESET_TOGGLES_LIBUSB_COMPAT compile time option to the AVRISP-MKII clone programmer project (thanks to Robert Spitzenpfeil) + * + * <b>Changed:</b> + * - Core: + * - Android Accessory Host property strings changed from a struct of pointer to an array to prevent unaligned access on greater than 8-bit architectures + * - Audio Device Class driver changed to also require the index of the Audio Control interface within the device, for SET/GET/CUR/MIN/MAX/RES property adjustments + * - Removed variable axis support from the HID_DESCRIPTOR_JOYSTICK() macro due to OS incompatibilities, replaced with fixed 3-axis joystick report structure + * - Removed the old pseudo-scheduler from the library as it was unused and deprecated since the 090810 release + * - Endpoint indexes are now specified as full endpoint addresses within the device in device mode, rather than a logical index + * - The Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint() function no longer takes an endpoint direction as a parameter, as this is now deduced from the specified full endpoint + * address and type + * - The Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint() function no longer takes a number of banks as a special mask; the number of banks is now specified as an integer parameter + * - Endpoints are now configured via instances of a new struct USB_Endpoint_Table_t in all device mode class drivers, rather than a list of endpoint parameters + * - Pipe indexes are now specified as full pipe addresses within the host in host mode, rather than a logical index + * - The Pipe_ConfigurePipe() function no longer takes an pipe token as a parameter, as this is now deduced from the specified full pipe address and type + * - The Pipe_ConfigurePipe() function no longer takes a number of banks as a special mask; the number of banks is now specified as an integer parameter + * - Pipes are now configured via instances of a new struct USB_Pipe_Table_t in all host mode class drivers, rather than a list of pipe parameters + * - Added support for various assert and debugging macros for the UC3 devices + * - Changed MIDI event structure MIDI_EventPacket_t to use a single field for the combined virtual cable index and command ID, to prevent bitfield packing issues + * on some architectures (thanks to Darren Gibbs) + * - Changed board LED driver implementations of LEDs_ToggleLEDs() for the AVR8 architecture to use the fast PIN register toggle alternative function for speed + * - Library Applications: + * - Raised the guard bits in the AVRISP-MKII clone project when in PDI and TPI to 32, to prevent communication errors on low quality connections to a target + * - Added additional bootloader API data to expose the bootloader start address and class to the DFU and CDC class bootloaders + * - Reverted AVRISP-MKII clone project watchdog based command timeout patch in favour of a hardware timer, to allow for use in devices with WDTRST fuse programmed + * - The library bootloaders will now correctly start the user application after a watchdog-based application start, even if the /HWB line is held low externally + * during the reset phase + * - Increased endpoint polling interval for all demos and projects to 5ms, as 1ms was causing some enumeration issues on some machines (thanks to Riku Salminen) + * + * <b>Fixed:</b> + * - Core: + * - Fixed possible enumeration error if the user application selects a pipe other than the default Control pipe between the Powered and Default states of + * the host state machine + * - Fixed incorrect call to the user callback CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetInterfaceProperty() in the Audio Class device driver (thanks to Tiit Ratsep) + * - Fixed compile error for the UC3 architecture when INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT is specified (thanks to Andrus Aaslaid) + * - Fixed compile error if LEDs_Disable() is called and BOARD=NONE is set (thanks to Sam Lin) + * - Fixed inverted LED logic in the OLIMEX162 board LED driver + * - Fixed incorrect response to GET STATUS requests in device mode if NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER or NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP tokens are defined (thanks to Georg Glock) + * - Fixed inverted LED logic in the USB2AX board LED driver + * - Fixed possible deadlock in the CDC device driver if the USB connection is dropped while the CDC_REQ_SetLineEncoding control request is being processed by + * the stack (thanks to Jonathan Hudgins) + * - Fixed broken MIDI host driver MIDI_Host_ReceiveEventPacket() function due to not unfreezing the MIDI data IN pipe before use (thanks to Michael Brown) + * - Fixed swapped Little Endian/Big Endian endpoint and pipe write code for the UC3 devices (thanks to Andrew Chu) + * - Fixed the JTAG_DISABLE() macro clearing all other bits in MCUSR when called + * - Fixed incorrect Micropendous board LED driver LEDs_SetAllLEDs() and LEDs_ChangeLEDs() function implementations (thanks to MitchJS) + * - Fixed endianess issues in the RNDIS host class driver for UC3 devices (thanks to Andrew Chu) + * - Library Applications: + * - Fixed error in the AVRISP-MKII programmer when ISP mode is used at 64KHz (thanks to Ben R. Porter) + * - Fixed AVRISP-MKII programmer project failing to compile for the U4 chips when VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL is defined to an invalid channel and NO_VTARGET_DETECT is + * defined (thanks to Steven Morehouse) + * - Fixed AVRISP-MKII programmer project reset line polarity inverted when the generated EEP file is loaded into the USB AVR's EEPROM and avr-dude is used + * - Fixed CDC and DFU bootloaders failing to compile when the bootloader section size is 8KB or more (thanks to Georg Glock) + * - Fixed CDC and DFU bootloaders API function offsets incorrect on some devices (thanks to Rod DeMay) + * - Fixed incorrect DFU version number reported to the host in the DFU bootloader descriptors (thanks to Georg Glock) + * - Fixed incorrect version hundredths value encoding in VERSION_BCD() macro (thanks to Georg Glock) + * - Fixed invalid configuration descriptor in the low level KeyboardMouse device demo (thanks to Jun Wako) + * - Fixed CDC and DFU bootloaders API page erase and write function failures (thanks to Martin Lambert) + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog120219 Version 120219 + * <b>New:</b> + * - Core: + * - Added support for the XMEGA A3BU Xplained board + * - Added support for the new B series XMEGA devices + * - Added support for version 2 of the Teensy boards (thanks to Christoph Redecker) + * - Added support for the USB2AX boards, hardware revision 1-3 + * - Added new Android Accessory Host class driver + * - Added new USB_Host_GetDescriptor(), USB_Host_GetDeviceConfiguration() and USB_Host_GetInterfaceAltSetting() functions + * - Added new CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetInterfaceProperty() callback to the Audio Device Class driver + * - Added new LEDs_Disable(), Buttons_Disable() and Joystick_Disable() functions to the board hardware drivers + * - Added support for the Micropendous family of boards (Arduino-like revisions 1 and 2, DIP, 32U2, A, 1, 2, 3 and 4) + * - Added INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE and NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT compile time options (thanks to Opendous Inc.) + * - Added support for the Atmel XMEGA B1 Xplained board + * - Added Serial USART peripheral driver for the XMEGA architecture + * - Added Master Mode SPI USART peripheral driver for the XMEGA and AVR8 architectures + * - Added build test to verify correct compilation of as many modules as possible under as many architectures as possible under the C and C++ languages + * - Added build test to verify correct compilation of the USB driver when forced into single USB mode under as many architectures as possible + * - Library Applications: + * - Added User Application APIs to the CDC and DFU class bootloaders + * - Added INVERTED_ISP_MISO compile time option to the AVRISP-MKII clone project (thanks to Chuck Rohs) + * - Added new Android Accessory Host demo (thanks to Opendous Inc.) + * + * <b>Changed:</b> + * - Core: + * - When automatic PLL management mode is enabled on the U4 series AVR8 chips, the PLL is now configured for 48MHz and not + * a divided 96MHz, to lower power consumption and to keep the system within the datasheet specs for 3.3V operation (thanks to Scott Vitale) + * - Added Class, ClassDevice, ClassHost and ClassCommon to the internal class driver source filenames to prevent ambiguities + * - Altered the Mass Storage Host class driver so that SCSI data STALLs from the attached device can be recovered from automatically without + * having to reset the Mass Storage interface + * - USB_CONFIG_ATTR_BUSPOWERED constant renamed to USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED, as this was misnamed (thanks to NXP Semiconductors) + * - Reordered board name definition indexes so that a misspelled BOARD compile option will default to BOARD_USER rather than BOARD_USBKEY + * - Altered the HID class driver to only try to construct at maximum one packet per USB frame, to reduce CPU usage + * - All USB Class Driver configuration struct values are now non-const, to allow for run-time modifications if required before configuring an instance + * - Library Applications: + * - Altered the Mass Storage Host LowLevel demo so that SCSI data STALLs from the attached device can be recovered from automatically without + * having to reset the Mass Storage interface + * - Updated the AVRISP-MKII Clone programmer project to be compatible with the latest version of AVR Studio (version 5.1) + * - Changed the AVRISP-MKII Clone programmer project to report a fixed 3.3V VTARGET voltage on USB AVRs lacking an ADC instead of 5V to prevent + * warnings in AVR Studio 5.1 when programming XMEGA devices + * - Allow serial strings to be generated on the older AVR8 devices which do not explicitly state they contain unique values in the datasheet, + * as this appears to be implemented in hardware + * + * <b>Fixed:</b> + * - Core: + * - Fixed ring buffer size limited to 255 elements, instead of the intended 65535 elements. + * - Fixed CDC class drivers not saving and sending all 16-bits of the control line states (thanks to Matthew Swabey) + * - Fixed race conditions in the CDC, HID and Mass Storage class drivers when processing some control requests + * - Fixed misspelled HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFIER_* macros in the HID class driver (thanks to Laszlo Monda) + * - Fixed broken AVR32 endpoint/pipe communications when ORDERED_EP_CONFIG compile time option is not enabled (thanks to Matthias Jahr) + * - Fixed broken compilation for the AVR32 devices if the NO_SOF_EVENTS compile time option was not enabled (thanks to Matthias Jahr) + * - Fixed compiler warning on GCC with \c -wundef compile flag is used (thanks to Georg Glock) + * - Fixed incorrect implementation of LEDs_ToggleLEDs() for the Adafruit-U4 board (thanks to Caroline Saliman) + * - Fixed broken compilation of LUFA under C++ compilers when the Serial peripheral module header file is included in a C++ source file + * - Fixed missing semicolon in the UC3 architecture host pipe functions + * - Fixed failed compilation for the XMEGA architecture if USB_DEVICE_ONLY us not specified + * - Fixed UC3 architecture ignoring the pipe size when Pipe_ConfigurePipe() is called + * - Library Applications: + * - Added reliability patches to the AVRISP-MKII Clone project's PDI/TPI protocols (thanks to Justin Mattair) + * - Fixed AVRISP-MKII Clone compile warning on AVR8 U4 targets even when NO_VTARGET_DETECT is enabled + * - Fixed AVRISP-MKII Clone failing to start application firmware once a TPI programming session is exited + * - Fixed DFU class bootloader not resetting the LED pins as high impedance inputs when a software jump to the user applications is requested + * - Fixed AVRISP-MKII Clone timing out on long programming commands such as programming the EEPROM on an ATMEGA8 (thanks to Martin Kelling) + * - Fixed invalid PID value used in the TempDataLogger project host application (thanks to Anupam Pathak) + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog111009 Version 111009 + * <b>New:</b> + * - Core: + * - Added USE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER compile time option to include a LUFAConfig.h header in the user director for LUFA configuration + * tokens as an alternative to tokens defined in the project makefile + * - Added new USB_Host_SetInterfaceAltSetting() convenience function for the selection of an interface's alternative setting + * - Added Audio class control request definitions + * - Added new CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetEndpointProperty() callback to the Audio Device Class driver to allow for endpoint control manipulations + * such as data sample rates + * - Added support for the Audio class GET STATUS request in the Audio Device Class driver so that it is correctly ACKed when sent by the host + * - Added new EVENT_Audio_Device_StreamStartStop() event to the Audio Device Class driver to detect stream start/stop events + * - Added board driver support for the Busware TUL board + * - Added board hardware driver support for the EVK1100 board + * - Added board hardware driver support for the EVK1104 board + * - Added new Host mode Audio Class driver + * - Added new SPI_GetCurrentMode() function to the SPI peripheral driver + * - Added RingBuffer_GetFreeCount() function to the Ring Buffer driver + * - Added new HID_Host_SetIdlePeriod() function to the HID Host Class driver + * - Added new USB_Host_ConfigurationNumber global variable to indicate the selected configuration in an attached device + * - Added new USB_Host_GetDeviceStatus() function to the host standard request function set + * - Added AVR USB XMEGA architecture port (currently incomplete/experimental) + * - Added new STRINGIFY() and STRINGIFY_EXPANDED() convenience macros + * - Added new JTAG_DISABLE() macro for the AVR8 architecture + * - Added Device Qualifier standard descriptor structure definitions USB_StdDescriptor_DeviceQualifier_t and USB_Descriptor_DeviceQualifier_t + * - Library Applications: + * - Added RNDIS device mode to the Webserver project + * - Added new incomplete AndroidAccessoryHost Host LowLevel demo + * - Added new HIDReportViewer project + * - Added new MediaControl project + * - Added new AudioInputHost Host ClassDriver demo + * - Added new AudioOutputHost Host ClassDriver demo + * - Added new AudioInputHost Host LowLevel demo + * - Added new AudioOutputHost Host LowLevel demo + * - Added new "checksource" target to all library project makefiles + * - Added new VTARGET_USE_INTERNAL_REF configuration option to the AVRISP-MKII clone project (thanks to Volker Bosch) + * + * <b>Changed:</b> + * - Core: + * - Altered the definition of the USB_Audio_Descriptor_Format_t descriptor so that the user is now responsible for supplying + * the supported audio sampling rates, to allow for multiple audio interfaces with different numbers of supported rates and/or + * continuous sample rates + * - Pipe_BoundEndpointNumber() has been renamed to Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress(), and now returns the correct endpoint direction + * as part of the endpoint address + * - Renamed global state variables that are specific to a certain USB mode to clearly indicate which mode the variable relates to, + * by changing the USB_* prefix to USB_Device_* or USB_Host_* + * - Removed the HOST_STATE_WaitForDeviceRemoval and HOST_STATE_Suspended host state machine states, as these are no longer required + * - Altered the USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration() function to update the global Host state machine state and the new + * USB_Host_ConfigurationNumber global as required + * - Added endian correcting code to the library USB class drivers for multiple architecture support + * - Removed the ENDPOINT_DESCRIPTOR_DIR_* macros, replaced by ENDPOINT_DIR_* instead + * - Renamed the JTAG_DEBUG_ASSERT() macro to JTAG_ASSERT() + * - Added variable number of axis to HID_DESCRIPTOR_JOYSTICK() for multi-axis joysticks above just X and Y + * - Renamed USB_Host_ClearPipeStall() to USB_Host_ClearEndpointStall() as the function works on an endpoint address within the attached device, + * and not a Pipe within the host + * - The MS_Host_ResetMSInterface() now performs a full Mass Storage reset sequence to prevent data corruption in the event of a device + * lock up or timeout (thanks to David Lyons) + * - Added endian-correction to the CDC driver's Line Encoding control request handlers. + * - Library Applications: + * - Modified the Low Level and Class Driver AudioInput and AudioOutput demos to support multiple audio sample rates + * - Updated all host mode demos and projects to use the EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete() event callback for device configuration + * instead of manual host state machine manipulations in the main application task + * - Changed the reports in the GenericHID device demos to control the board LEDs, to reduce user confusion over the callback routines + * - Added reliability patches to the AVRISP-MKII Clone project's ISP and PDI/TPI protocols (thanks to Justin Mattair) + * + * <b>Fixed:</b> + * - Core: + * - Large number of documentation and code comment corrections (thanks to Andrey from Microsin.ru) + * - Fixed possibility of the AVR's SPI interface being pulled out of master mode if the /SS pin is a input and pulled low (thanks + * to Andrey from Microsin.ru) + * - Fixed compile error when FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE compile time option was disabled, and a USE_*_DESCRIPTORS compile time + * option was not enabled on the AVR8s + * - Fixed lack of C++ compatibility in some internal header files causing compile errors when using LUFA in C++ projects + * - Fixed error in the pipe unordered allocation algorithm for the AVR8 devices breaking compatibility with some devices + * - Fixed USB_USBTask not being called internally in stream transfers between packets when Partial Stream Transfers are used + * - Fixed swapped TWI_ADDRESS_READ and TWI_ADDRESS_WRITE values + * - Fixed TWI_ReadPacket() not releasing the TWI bus on read completion + * - Fixed optimization error in the HID Parser item value USB_SetHIDReportItemInfo() and USB_GetHIDReportItemInfo() routines if the report item was + * \c NULL (which should be allowable according to the API) + * - Fixed HID Parser CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem() callback function not being passed a cacheable report item pointer + * - Fixed HID Parser's largest report size bit count not including the size of the last parsed report item + * - Fixed HID host driver's largest HID report size count corrupt when the number of report bits exceeds 255 + * - Library Applications: + * - Fixed incorrect signature in the CDC and DFU class bootloaders for the ATMEGA8U2 + * - Fixed KeyboardHost and KeyboardHostWithParser demos displaying incorrect values when numerical keys were pressed + * - Fixed compile errors in the incomplete BluetoothHost demo application (thanks to Timo Lindfors) + * - Fixed incorrect Dataflash buffer use in the DataflashManager_WriteBlocks_RAM() function of several demos/projects (thanks to Jeremy Willden) + * - Fixed incorrect logging interval (always 500ms longer than requested) in the TempDataLogger project + * - Fixed incorrect buffer size check in the USBtoSerial project (thanks to Yuri A Nikiforov) + * - Fixed port state table corruption in the TCP layer of the RNDIS Ethernet device demos + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog110528 Version 110528 + * <b>New:</b> + * - Core: + * - Added new ORDERED_EP_CONFIG compile time option to restrict endpoint/pipe configuration to ascending order + * in exchange for a smaller compiled program binary size + * - Added a new general RingBuff.h miscellaneous ring buffer library driver header + * - Added new GCC_FORCE_POINTER_ACCESS() macro to correct GCC's mishandling of struct pointer accesses + * - Added new GCC_MEMORY_BARRIER() macro to prevent instruction reordering across boundaries + * - Added basic driver example use code to the library documentation + * - Added new Endpoint_Null_Stream() and Pipe_Null_Stream() functions + * - Added new ADC_GET_CHANNEL_MASK() convenience macro + * - Added new HID report item macros (with HID_RI_ prefix) to allow for easy creation and editing of HID report descriptors + * - Added new HID_DESCRIPTOR_MOUSE(), HID_DESCRIPTOR_KEYBOARD(), HID_DESCRIPTOR_JOYSTICK() and HID_DESCRIPTOR_VENDOR() macros + * for easy automatic creation of basic USB HID device reports + * - Added new MAX() and MIN() convenience macros + * - Added new Serial_SendData() function to the Serial driver + * - Added board driver support for the Sparkfun ATMEGA8U2 breakout board + * - Added TWI baud rate prescaler and bit length parameters to the TWI_Init() function (thanks to Thomas Herlinghaus) + * - Internal restructuring for eventual multiple architecture ports + * - Added AVR32 UC3 architecture port (currently incomplete/experimental) + * - Added new architecture independent functions to enable, disable, save and restore the Global Interrupt Enable flags + * - Added new RNDIS Device Class Driver packet send and receive functions + * - Library Applications: + * - Added ability to write protect Mass Storage disk write operations from the host OS + * - Added new MIDIToneGenerator project + * - Added new KeyboardMouseMultiReport Device ClassDriver demo + * - Added new VirtualSerialMassStorage Device ClassDriver demo + * - Added HID class bootloader, compatible with a modified version of the command line Teensy loader from PJRC.com + * - Added LED flashing to the CDC and DFU class bootloaders to indicate when they are running + * + * <b>Changed:</b> + * - Core: + * - Unordered Endpoint/Pipe configuration is now allowed once again by default via the previous reconfig workaround + * - Refactored Host mode Class Driver *_Host_ConfigurePipes() routines to be more space efficient when compiled + * - Added new *_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed error codes for the *_Host_ConfigurePipes() routines + * - The USARTStream global is now public and documented in the SerialStream module, allowing for the serial USART + * stream to be accessed via its handle rather than via the implicit stdout and stdin streams + * - The FAST_STREAM_TRANSFERS compile time option has been removed due to lack of use and low cost/benefit ratio + * - Altered all endpoint/pipe stream transfers so that the new BytesProcessed parameter now points to a location + * where the number of bytes in the transfer that have been completed can be stored (or NULL if entire transaction + * should be performed in one chunk) + * - The NO_STREAM_CALLBACKS compile time option has now been removed due to the new partial stream transfer feature + * - Changed over all project and demo HID report descriptors to use the new HID report item macros + * - Moved the HIDParser.c source file to the LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/ directory from the LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/ + * - Added support to the HID parser for extended USAGE items that contain the usage page as well as the usage index + * - Removed the SerialStream driver, rolled functionality into the regular Serial peripheral driver via the new + * Serial_CreateStream() and Serial_CreateBlockingStream() functions + * - Renamed the low level Serial byte send/receive functions, to be consistent with the CDC class driver byte functions + * - Altered the behaviour of the serial byte reception function so that is is non-blocking, and now returns a negative + * value if no character is received (to remain consistent with the CDC class driver byte reception routines) + * - Renamed the PRNT_Host_SendString(), CDC_Host_SendString() and CDC_Device_SendString() functions to *_SendData(), and + * added new versions of the *_SendString() routines that expect a null terminated string instead + * - Renamed all driver termination *_ShutDown() functions to the more logical name *_Disable() + * - Reduced latency for executing the Start-Of-Frame events (if enabled in the user application) + * - Removed Pipe_ClearErrorFlags(), pipe error flags are now automatically cleared when Pipe_ClearError() is called + * - Endpoint_ResetFIFO() renamed to Endpoint_ResetEndpoint(), to be consistent with the Pipe_ResetPipe() function name + * - Implemented on-demand PLL clock generation for the U4, U6 and U7 series USB AVRs when automatic PLL mode is specified + * - F_CLOCK changed to F_USB to be more descriptive, and applicable on future architecture ports + * - Renamed all low level Endpoint_Read_*, Endpoint_Write_* and Endpoint_Discard_* functions to use the number of bits instead of + * a symbolic size (Byte, Word, DWord) so that the function names are applicable and correct across all architectures + * - Renamed all low level Pipe_Read_*, Pipe_Write_* and Pipe_Discard_* functions to use the number of bits instead of + * a symbolic size (Byte, Word, DWord) so that the function names are applicable and correct across all architectures + * - Separated out board drivers by architecture in the library internals for better organisation + * - Library Applications: + * - Changed the XPLAINBridge software UART to use the regular timer CTC mode instead of the alternative CTC mode + * via the Input Capture register, to reduce user confusion + * - Combined page and word ISP programming mode code in the AVRISP-MKII clone project to reduce compiled size and + * increase maintainability of the code + * - Changed over library projects to use the new general ring buffer library driver module + * - Added new high level TWI packet read/write commands, altered behaviour of the TWI_StartTransmission() function + * - Changed TempDataLogger project's DS1307 driver to simplify the function interface and prevent a possible race condition + * - Changed AVRISP-MKII project to use the Watchdog interrupt for command timeouts, to reduce CPU usage and free timer 0 + * for other uses + * - Updated the software USART code in the XPLAIN Bridge application so that the incoming bits are sampled at their mid-point + * instead of starting point, to give maximum reliability (thanks to Anton Staaf) + * + * <b>Fixed:</b> + * - Core: + * - Fixed broken USBFOO board drivers due to missing BOARD_USBFOO define + * - Fixed HID host class driver incorrectly binding to HID devices that do not have an OUT endpoint + * - Fixed incorrect definition of the HID_KEYBOARD_SC_D constant in the HID class driver (thanks to Opendous Inc.) + * - Fixed incorrect definition of the HID_KEYBOARD_SC_RIGHT_ARROW constant in the HID class driver (thanks to Joby Taffey) + * - Fixed incorrect endpoint initialisation order in the several device demos (thanks to Rick Drolet) + * - Fixed inverted Minimus board LEDs + * - Fixed incorrect byte ordering in the Audio_Device_WriteSample24 function (thanks to WZab) + * - Fixed several functions in the Host mode Still Image Class driver returning an error code from the incorrect + * error code enum (thanks to Daniel Seibert) + * - Fixed ReportID not being removed from the feature/out report data array in the HID class driver when Report IDs are used + * - Fixed incorrect BUTTONS_BUTTON1 definition for the Minimus board + * - Fixed Still Image Host class driver exiting the descriptor search routine prematurely if the data pipes (but not event pipe) + * is found + * - Fixed missing call to Pipe_SetInfiniteINRequests() in the Pipe_ConfigurePipe() routine + * - Fixed Remote Wakeup broken on the AVRs due to the mechanism only operating when the SUSPI bit is set (thanks to Holger Steinhaus) + * - Fixed possible invalid program execution when in host mode if corrupt descriptor lengths are supplied by the attached device + * - Library Applications: + * - Fixed Benito project discarding incoming data from the USB virtual serial port when the USART is busy + * - Fixed broken DFU bootloader, added XPLAIN support for bootloader start when XCK jumpered to ground + * - Fixed broken HID_REQ_GetReport request handler in the Low Level GenericHID demo + * - Fixed possible lost data in the XPLAINBridge, USBtoSerial and Benito projects when the host exceeds the packet + * timeout period on received packets as set by USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS (thanks to Justin Rajewski) + * - Fixed possible programming problem in the AVRISP-MKII clone project when programming specific patterns into a target + * memory space that is only byte (not page) addressable + * - Fixed errors in the incomplete Test and Measurement device demo preventing proper operation (thanks to Pavel Plotnikov) + * - Fixed programming errors in the AVRISP-MKII project when the programming packet is a round multiple of the endpoint bank + * size under avrdude (thanks to Steffan Woltjer) + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog101122 Version 101122 + * <b>New:</b> + * - Core: + * - Added new SCSI_ASENSE_NOT_READY_TO_READY_CHANGE constant to the Mass Storage class driver, to indicate when a previously + * not ready removable medium has now become ready for the host's use (thanks to Martin Degelsegger) + * - Moved the Pipe and Endpoint stream related code to two new USB library core source files EndpointStream.c and PipeStream.c + * - Added new USB_Device_GetFrameNumber() and USB_Host_GetFrameNumber() functions to retrieve the current USB frame number + * - Added new USB_Host_EnableSOFEvents(), USB_Host_DisableSOFEvents() and EVENT_USB_Host_StartOfFrame() for the user application + * handling of USB Start of Frame events while in USB Host mode + * - Added new PRNT_Host_BytesReceived(), PRNT_Host_ReceiveByte(), PRNT_Host_SendByte() and PRNT_Host_Flush() functions to the + * Print Host Class driver + * - Added class specific descriptor alternative struct type defines with standard USB-IF element naming + * - Added new project makefile template to the library and moved board driver stub files into in a new "CodeTemplates" directory + * - Added board hardware driver support for the Adafruit U4 breakout board + * - Added board hardware driver support for the Arduino Uno development board + * - Added board hardware driver support for the Blackcat USB JTAG board (thanks to the PSGroove team) + * - Added board hardware driver support for the Busware BUI development board + * - Added board hardware driver support for the Busware CUL V3 868MHZ radio board (thanks to Dirk Tostmann) + * - Added board hardware driver support for the Kernel Concepts USBFOO development board + * - Added board hardware driver support for the Linnix UDIP development board + * - Added board hardware driver support for the Olimex AVR-USB-162 development board (thanks to Steve Fawcett) + * - Added board hardware driver support for the Maximus board (thanks to the PSGroove team) + * - Added board hardware driver support for the Microsin AVR-USB162 breakout board + * - Added board hardware driver support for the Minimus board (thanks to the PSGroove team) + * - Added new NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH compile time option to disable automatic flushing of interfaces when the USB management + * tasks for each driver is called + * - Added standard keyboard HID report scan-code defines (thanks to Laszlo Monda) + * - Added new Pipe_GetBusyBanks(), Endpoint_GetBusyBanks() and Endpoint_AbortPendingIN() functions + * - Library Applications: + * - Added default test tone generation mode to the Device mode AudioInput demos + * - Added new NO_BLOCK_SUPPORT, NO_EEPROM_BYTE_SUPPORT, NO_FLASH_BYTE_SUPPORT and NO_LOCK_BYTE_WRITE_SUPPORT compile time options to the + * CDC class bootloader + * - Added new XCK_RESCUE_CLOCK_ENABLE compile time option to the AVRISP-MKII clone programmer project (thanks to Tom Light) + * + * <b>Changed:</b> + * - Core: + * - Removed complicated logic for the Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint() function to use inlined or function called versions + * depending of if the given bank size is a compile time constant, as the compiler does a better job of optimizing + * with basic code + * - Changed the signature of the CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor() callback function so that the descriptor pointer is const, to remove + * the need for extra casting inside the callback (thanks to Jonathan Kollasch) + * - Reduced HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS to 1000ms down from 1500ms to improve device compatibility while in USB Host mode + * - Removed the EVENT_USB_InitFailure() event, not specifying a USB mode correctly now defaults to UID selection mode + * - Renamed and moved class driver common constant definitions to make the naming scheme more uniform + * - Moved the USB mode specifier constants into a new enum, so that they are semantically related to one another + * - Renamed ENDPOINT_DOUBLEBANK_SUPPORTED() to ENDPOINT_BANKS_SUPPORTED() and changed it to return the maximum number of supported banks for + * the given endpoint + * - Better algorithm to extract and convert the internal device serial number into a string descriptor (if present) + * - All USB class drivers are now automatically included when LUFA/Drivers/USB.h is included, and no longer need to be separately included + * - The MIDI class drivers now automatically flushes the MIDI interface when the MIDI class driver's USBTask() function is called + * - Renamed the EVENT_USB_Device_UnhandledControlRequest() event to EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() as it is now fired before the library + * request handlers, not afterwards + * - Library Applications: + * - Changed over all device demos to use a clearer algorithm for the configuring of the application's endpoints + * - Added missing DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation() function to the MassStorageKeyboard demo, removed redundant + * SCSI_Codes.h file as these values are part of the MassStorage Class Driver + * - Added compile time error to the AVRISP-MKII project when built for the U4 chips, as the default VTARGET detection ADC channel + * does not exist on these chips (thanks to Marco) + * - Changed all Device mode LowLevel demos and Device Class drivers so that the control request is acknowledged and any data + * transferred as quickly as possible without any processing in between sections, so that long callbacks or event handlers will + * not break communications with the host by exceeding the maximum control request stage timeout period + * - Changed over all demos, drivers and internal functions to use the current frame number over the Start of Frame flag where possible + * to free up the Start of Frame flag for interrupt use in the user application + * - All project makefiles now correctly clean intermediate build files from assembly and C++ sources (thanks to Daniel Czigany) + * - Changed default value for the reset polarity parameter in the AVRISP-MKII project so that it defaults to active low drive + * - Changed configuration descriptor parser for all host mode projects and class drivers to ensure better compatibility with devices + * - All LowLevel demos changed to use the constants and types defined in the USB class drivers + * - Changed AudioInput and AudioOutput demos to reload the next sample via an interrupt rather than polling the sample timer + * - Rescue clock of the AVRISP-MKII moved to the AVR's OCR1A pin, so that the clock can be generated at all times + * - Changed ClassDriver MIDI demos to process all incoming events in a loop until the bank becomes empty rather than one at a time + * - Changed LowLevel MIDI demos to only clear the incoming event bank once it has become empty to support packed event packets + * + * <b>Fixed:</b> + * - Core: + * - Fixed USB_GetHIDReportItemInfo() function modifying the given report item's data when the report item does not exist + * within the supplied report of a multiple report HID device + * - Fixed critical pipe/endpoint memory allocation issue where the bank memory address space could be silently overlapped + * in the USB controller if the endpoints or pipes were allocated in anything other than ascending order (thanks to Martin Degelsegger) + * - Added LEDs_ToggleLEDs() function to several board LED drivers which were missing it (thanks to Andrei Krainev) + * - Fixed SET FEATURE and CLEAR FEATURE control requests directed at an unconfigured endpoint causing request timeouts + * - Fixed USB_Host_ClearPipeStall() incorrectly determining the endpoint direction from the currently selected pipe + * - Fixed JTAG_DEBUG_POINT() and JTAG_DEBUG_BREAK() macros not compiling under pure C99 standards mode + * - Fixed endpoint selection within the CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport() callback function causing broken GET REPORT requests + * - Fixed incorrect command name for EEPROM memory programming in the makefile dfu-ee target + * - Fixed incorrect LEDs_ChangeLEDs() function in the Benito board LED driver + * - Fixed incorrect USB_DeviceState value when unconfiguring the device without an address set + * - Fixed SPI driver not explicitly setting /SS and MISO pins as inputs when SPI_Init() is called + * - Fixed random enumeration failure while in device mode due to interrupts causing the Set Address request to exceed maximum timings + * - Fixed MIDI_Host_Flush() not aborting early when the specified MIDI host interface was not configured + * - Fixed MIDI class driver send routines silently discarding packets if the endpoint or pipe is busy (thanks to Robin Green) + * - Library Applications: + * - Fixed MassStorage based demos and projects resetting the SCSI sense values before the command is executed, leading to + * missed SCSI sense values when the host retrieves the sense key (thanks to Martin Degelsegger) + * - Fixed USBtoSerial and Benito project SetLineEncoding calls failing if the USART is busy, due to the RX ISR delaying the control + * request handler + * - Fixed LowLevel PrinterHost demo not sending control requests to the attached printer with the correct printer interface wIndex value + * - Fixed incorrect signature reported in the CDC class bootloader for the ATMEGA32U2 + * - Fixed BootloaderCDC project failing on some operating systems due to removed Line Encoding options (thanks to Alexey Belyaev) + * - Fixed broken FLASH/EEPROM programming in the AVRISP-MKII clone project when writing in non-paged mode and the polling byte cannot be used + * - Fixed ISR definition conflict in the XPLAIN bridge between the software UART and the AVRISP-MKII ISP modules + * - Fixed USBtoSerial and XPLAINBridge demos discarding data from the PC if the send buffer becomes full + * - Fixed broken input in the MagStripe reader project due to an incorrect HID report descriptor + * - Fixed incorrect PollingIntervalMS values in the demo/project/bootloader endpoint descriptors (thanks to MCS Electronics) + * - Fixed AVRISP-MKII clone project not starting the target's program automatically after exiting TPI programming mode + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog100807 Version 100807 + * <b>New:</b> + * - Added new ADC_DisableChannel() function (thanks to Mich Davis) + * - Added new VTARGET_REF_VOLTS and VTARGET_SCALE_FACTOR compile time defines to the AVRISP-MKII programmer project to set + * the VTARGET reference voltage and scale factor + * - Added new pgm_read_ptr() macro to Common.h for reading of pointers out of flash memory space + * - Added new SWAPENDIAN_16() and SWAPENDIAN_32() macros to Common.h for statically initialized variables at compile time + * - Added new Drivers/USB/LowLevel/Device.c file to house Device mode specific functions that are more complicated than simple macros + * - Added new AVRStudio 4 project files for all library demos, projects and bootloaders + * - Added ability to set the serial baud rate via the user's terminal in the XPLAINBridge project + * - Added new LUFA module variables for the different source modules in the core library makefile to simplify project makefiles + * - Added start of a new Test and Measurement class demo (thanks to Peter Lawrence) + * - Added new SPI_ORDER_* data order masks to the SPI peripheral driver + * - Added support to the AVRISP-MKII project for ISP speeds slower than 125KHz via a new software SPI driver + * - Added support for the new button/LED on the latest model USBTINY-MKII + * + * <b>Changed:</b> + * - The RingBuff library code has been replaced in the XPLAINBridge, Benito and USBtoSerial projects with an ultra lightweight + * ring buffer to help improve the reliability of the projects + * - The EEPROM stream read/write functions now use eeprom_update_byte() instead of eeprom_write_byte(), so that only + * changed bytes are written to EEPROM to preserve its lifespan + * - Changed over the AVRISP-MKII and TemperatureDataLogger projects to use eeprom_update_byte() when writing non-volatile + * parameters to EEPROM to preserve its lifespan + * - Removed unused line encoding data and control requests from the CDC Bootloader code, to save space + * - Renamed SERIAL_STREAM_ASSERT() macro to STDOUT_ASSERT() + * - The USB_Device_IsRemoteWakeupSent() and USB_Device_IsUSBSuspended() macros have been deleted, as they are now obsolete + * - Rewrote the implementation of the SwapEndian_16() and SwapEndian_32() functions so that they compile down in most instances to + * minimal loads and stores rather than complicated shifts + * - The software UART in the XPLAINBridge has been largely altered to try to improve upon its performance and reliability + * - The USBtoSerial and Benito projects now flushes received data via a flush timer, so that several bytes can be transmitted at once + * - Removed the automated checking of event names in the demo, project and bootloader makefiles due to inconsistencies between the + * behaviour of the command line tools used to perform the check on each platform + * - Internal USB driver source files renamed and moved to ease future possible architecture ports + * - All internal pseudo-function macros have been converted to true inline functions for type-safety and readability + * - Changed LED indicator masks for the AVRISP-MKII project, so that there are defined roles for each LED + * - Altered the CDC Device and Host Class drivers' receive byte routines, so that no data is indicated by the function returning a + * negative value (thanks to Andreas Paulin) + * - Added auto flushing of OUT data to the CDC Host Class driver's USBTask function to automatically flush the send pipe buffer + * + * <b>Fixed:</b> + * - Fixed AVRISP project sending a LOAD EXTENDED ADDRESS command to 128KB AVRs after programming or reading from + * the last page of FLASH (thanks to Gerard Sexton) + * - Fixed AVRISP project not sending a full erase-and-write EEPROM command to XMEGA targets when writing to the EEPROM + * instead of the split write-only command (thanks to Tim Margush) + * - Fixed RNDISEthernet demos crashing when calculating checksums for Ethernet/TCP packets of more than ~500 bytes due to + * an overflow in the checksum calculation loop (thanks to Kevin Malec) + * - Fixed XPLAINBridge project not correctly reading the XMEGA's supply voltage when reporting back to the host + * - Fixed incorrect signature for the ATMEGA32U2 in the DFU bootloader (thanks to Axel Rohde) + * - Fixed internal device serial not being accessible on the ATMEGAXXU2 AVRs (thanks to Axel Rohde) + * - Fixed void pointer arithmetic in ConfigDescriptor.h breaking C++ compatibility (thanks to Michael Hennebry) + * - Fixed broken PDI EEPROM Section Erase functionality in the AVRISP-MKII project + * - Fixed USB_Device_SendRemoteWakeup() not working when the USB clock was frozen during USB bus suspend (thanks to Brian Dickman) + * - Fixed occasional lockup of the AVRISP project due to the timeout extension code incorrectly extending the timeout in + * PDI and TPI programming modes infinitely + * - Fixed HID device class driver still using PrevReportINBuffer for GetReport control requests even when it has been + * set to NULL by the user application (thanks to Axel Rohde) + * - Fixed MIDI_Device_SendEventPacket() not correctly waiting for the endpoint to become ready (thanks to Robin Green) + * - Fixed Benito and USBtoSerial projects not turning off the USART before reconfiguring it, which could cause incorrect + * operation to occur (thanks to Bob Paddock) + * - Fixed Serial peripheral driver not turning off the USART before reconfiguring it, which would cause incorrect operation + * to occur (thanks to Bob Paddock) + * - Fixed software application start command broken in the DFU class bootloader when dfu-programmer is used due to application + * start address corruption + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog100513 Version 100513 + * <b>New:</b> + * - Added incomplete MIDIToneGenerator project + * - Added new Relay Controller Board project (thanks to OBinou) + * - Added board hardware driver support for the Teensy, USBTINY MKII, Benito and JM-DB-U2 lines of third party USB AVR boards + * - Added new ATTR_NO_INIT variable attribute for global variables that should not be automatically cleared on startup + * - Added new ENDPOINT_*_BusSuspended error code to the Endpoint function, so that the stream functions early-abort if the bus + * is suspended before or during a transfer + * - Added new EVENT_CDC_Device_BreakSent() event and CDC_Host_SendBreak() function to the Device and Host CDC Class drivers + * - Added ReportType parameter to the HID device class driver CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport() function so that FEATURE + * reports from the host to the device can be correctly processed + * - Added ReportType parameter to the HID host class driver HID_Host_SendReportByID() function so that FEATURE reports can be + * issued to the attached device + * + * <b>Changed:</b> + * - AVRISP programmer project now has a more robust timeout system + * - Added a timeout value to the TWI_StartTransmission() function, within which the addressed device must respond + * - Webserver project now uses the board LEDs to indicate the current IP configuration state + * - Added ENABLE_TELNET_SERVER compile time option to the Webserver project to disable the TELNET server if desired + * - Increased throughput of the USBtoSerial demo on systems that send multiple bytes per packet (thanks to Opendous Inc.) + * - Double bank CDC endpoints in the XPLAIN Bridge project, re-enable JTAG once the mode selection pin has been sampled. + * - Standardized the naming scheme given to configuration descriptor sub-elements in the Device mode demos, bootloaders + * and projects + * - All Class Driver Host mode demos now correctly set the board LEDs to READY once the enumeration process has completed + * - Added LIBUSB_FILTERDRV_COMPAT compile time option to the AVRISP programmer project to make the code compatible with Windows + * builds of avrdude at the expense of AVRStudio compatibility + * - Removed two-step endpoint/pipe bank clear and switch sequence for smaller, faster endpoint/pipe code + * - The USB_Init() function no longer calls sei() - the user is now responsible for enabling interrupts when they are ready + * for them to be enabled (thanks to Andrei Krainev) + * - The Audio_Device_IsSampleReceived() and Audio_Device_IsReadyForNextSample() functions are now inline, to reduce overhead + * - Removed the cast to uint16_t on the set baud rate in the USBtoSerial project, so that the higher >1M baud rates can be + * selected (thanks to Steffan Woltjer) + * - Removed software PDI and TPI emulation from the AVRISP-MKII clone project as it was very buggy and slow - PDI and TPI must + * now be implemented via separate programming headers + * - The CDC class bootloader now uses a watchdog reset rather than a soft-reset when exited to ensure that all hardware is + * properly reset to their defaults + * - Device mode class driver callbacks are now fired before the control request status stage is sent to prevent the host from + * timing out if another request is immediately fired and the device has a lengthy callback routine + * - The TeensyHID bootloader has been removed, per request from Paul at PJRC + * - The LIBUSB_FILTERDRV_COMPAT compile time option in the XPLAINBridge and AVRISP-MKII projects has been renamed + * LIBUSB_DRIVER_COMPAT, as it applies to all software on all platforms using the libUSB driver + * + * <b>Fixed:</b> + * - Fixed possible device lockup when INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT is enabled and the control endpoint is not properly + * selected when the ISR completes + * - Fixed AVRISP-MKII clone project not correctly issuing LOAD EXTENDED ADDRESS commands when the extended address + * boundary is crossed during programming or read back (thanks to Gerard Sexton) + * - Fixed warnings when building the AVRISP-MKII clone project with the ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL compile time option disabled + * - Fixed software PDI/TPI programming mode in the AVRISP project not correctly toggling just the clock pin + * - Fixed TWI_StartTransmission() corrupting the contents of the GPIOR0 register + * - Fixed TWI driver not aborting when faced with no response after attempting to address a device on the bus + * - Fixed ADC routines not correctly returning the last result when multiple channels were read + * - Fixed ADC routines failing to read the extended channels (Channels 8 to 13, Internal Temperature Sensor) on the + * U4 series USB AVR parts + * - Fixed LowLevel MassStorage demo broken on the U2 series USB AVRs due to unsupported double-banked endpoint modes used + * - Fixed compilation error in the AudioInput demos when MICROPHONE_BIASED_TO_HALF_RAIL is defined (thanks to C. Scott Ananian) + * - Fixed incorrect definition of HID_ALIGN_DATA() causing incorrect HID report item data alignment + * - Fixed Still Image Host class driver not resetting the transaction ID when a new session is opened, fixed driver not sending + * a valid session ID to the device + * - Removed invalid dfu and flip related targets from the bootloaders - bootloaders can only be replaced with an external programmer + * - Fixed Set/Clear Feature requests directed to a non-configured endpoint not returning a stall to the host + * - Fixed HID Device Class Driver not allocating a temporary buffer when the host requests a report via the control endpoint and the + * user has set the PrevReportINBuffer driver configuration element to NULL (thanks to Lars Noschinski) + * - Fixed device state not being reset to DEVICE_STATE_Default if the host sets a 0x00 device address + * - Fixed device not stalling configuration requests before the device's address has been set + * - Fixed possibility of internal signature retrieval being corrupted if an interrupt occurs during a signature byte + * read (thanks to Andrei Krainev) + * - Fixed device state not being reset back to the default state if the host sets the address to 0 + * - Fixed Set Configuration requests not being stalled until the host has set the device's address + * - Fixed Host mode HID class driver not sending the correct report type when HID_Host_SendReportByID() was called and the + * HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY compile time option is set + * - Fixed INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT compile time option preventing other interrupts from occurring while the control endpoint + * request is being processed, causing possible lockups if a USB interrupt occurs during a transfer + * - Remove incorrect Abstract Call Management class specific descriptor from the CDC demos, bootloaders and projects + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog100219 Version 100219 + * + * <b>New:</b> + * - Added TPI programming support for 6-pin ATTINY devices to the AVRISP programmer project (thanks to Tom Light) + * - Added command timeout counter to the AVRISP project so that the device no longer freezes when incorrectly connected + * to a target + * - Added new TemperatureDataLogger application, a USB data logger which writes to the device's dataflash and appears to + * the host as a standard Mass Storage device when inserted + * - Added MIDI event packing support to the MIDI Device and Host mode Class drivers, allowing for multiple MIDI events to + * sent or received in packed form in a single USB packet + * - Added new MIDI send buffer flush routines to the MIDI Device and Host mode Class drivers, to flush packed events + * - Added master mode hardware TWI driver for easy TWI peripheral control + * - Added ADC MUX masks for the standard ADC input channels on all AVR models with an ADC, altered demos to use these masks + * as on some models, the channel number is not identical to its single-ended ADC MUX mask + * - New Webserver project, a RNDIS host USB webserver using the open source uIP TCP/IP network stack and FatFS library + * - New BOARD value option BOARD_NONE (equivalent to not specifying BOARD) which will remove all board hardware drivers which + * do not adversely affect the code operation (currently only the LEDs driver) + * - Added keyboard modifier masks (HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFER_*) and LED report masks (KEYBOARD_LED_*) to the HID class driver and + * Keyboard demos + * - Added .5MHz recovery clock to the AVRISP programmer project when in ISP programming mode to correct mis-set fuses + * + * <b>Changed:</b> + * - Slowed down software USART carried PDI programming in the AVRISP project to prevent transmission errors + * - Renamed the AVRISP project folder to AVRISP-MKII to reduce confusion + * - Renamed the RESET_LINE_* makefile tokens in the AVRISP MKII Project to AUX_LINE_*, as they are not always used for target + * reset + * - Changed over the MassStorageKeyboard Class driver device demo to use Start of Frame events rather than a timer to keep track + * of elapsed milliseconds + * - Inlined currently unused (but standardized) maintenance functions in the Device and Host Class drivers to save space + * - The XPLAINBridge project now selects between a USB to Serial bridge and a PDI programmer on startup, reading the JTAG port's + * TDI pin to determine which mode to use + * - Removed the stream example code from the Low Level VirtualSerial demos, as they were buggy and only served to add clutter + * + * <b>Fixed:</b> + * - Fixed AVRISP project not able to enter programming mode when ISP protocol is used + * - Fixed AVRISP PDI race condition where the guard time between direction changes could be interpreted as a start bit + * - Fixed ADC_IsReadingComplete() returning an inverted result + * - Fixed blocking CDC streams not aborting when the host is disconnected + * - Fixed XPLAIN board Dataflash driver broken due to incorrect preprocessor commands + * - Fixed inverted XPLAIN LED driver output (LED turned on when it was supposed to be turned off, and vice-versa) + * - Fixed Class Driver struct interface numbers in the KeyboardMouse and VirtualSerialMouse demos (thanks to Renaud Cerrato) + * - Fixed invalid USB controller PLL prescaler values for the ATMEGAxxU2 controllers + * - Fixed lack of support for the ATMEGA32U2 in the DFU and CDC class bootloaders + * - Fixed Benito project not resetting the target AVR automatically when programming has completed + * - Fixed DFU bootloader programming not discarding the correct number of filler bytes from the host when non-aligned programming + * ranges are specified (thanks to Thomas Bleeker) + * - Fixed CDC and RNDIS host demos and class drivers - bidirectional endpoints should use two separate pipes, not one half-duplex pipe + * - Fixed Pipe_IsEndpointBound() not taking the endpoint's direction into account + * - Fixed EEPROM and FLASH ISP programming in the AVRISP project + * - Fixed incorrect values of USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED and USB_CONFIG_ATTR_REMOTEWAKEUP tokens (thanks to Claus Christensen) + * - Fixed SerialStream driver blocking while waiting for characters to be received instead of returning EOF + * - Fixed SerialStream driver not setting stdin to the created serial stream (thanks to Mike Alexander) + * - Fixed USB_GetHIDReportSize() returning the number of bits in the specified report instead of bytes + * - Fixed AVRISP project not extending the command delay after each successful page/word/byte program + * - Fixed accuracy of the SERIAL_UBBRVAL() and SERIAL_2X_UBBRVAL() macros for higher baud rates (thanks to Renaud Cerrato) + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog091223 Version 091223 + * + * <b>New:</b> + * - Added activity LED indicators to the AVRISP project to indicate when the device is busy processing a command + * - The USB target family and allowable USB mode tokens are now public and documented (USB_CAN_BE_*, USB_SERIES_*_AVR) + * - Added new XPLAIN USB to Serial Bridge project (thanks to John Steggall for initial proof-of-concept, David Prentice + * and Peter Danneger for revised software USART code) + * - Added new RNDIS Ethernet Host LowLevel demo + * - Added new RNDIS Ethernet Host Class Driver + * - Added new RNDIS Ethernet Host ClassDriver demo + * - Added CDC_Host_Flush() function to the CDC Host Class driver to flush sent data to the attached device + * - Added PDI programming support for XMEGA devices to the AVRISP programmer project (thanks to Justin Mattair) + * - Added support for the XPLAIN board Dataflash, with new XPLAIN_REV1 board target for the different Dataflash used + * on the first revision boards compared to the one mounted on later revisions + * - Added new HID_ALIGN_DATA() macro to return the pre-retrieved value of a HID report item, left-aligned to a given datatype + * - Added new PreviousValue to the HID Report Parser report item structure, for easy monitoring of previous report item values + * - Added new EVK527 board target + * - Added new USB_Host_GetDeviceStringDescriptor() convenience function + * - Added new LEDNotification project to the library, to give a visual LED notification on new events from the host + * - Added new NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP and NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER compile time options + * + * <b>Changed:</b> + * - Removed code in the Keyboard demos to send zeroed reports between two reports with differing numbers of key codes + * as this relied on non-standard OS driver behaviour to repeat key groups + * - The SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t and SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t type defines are now part of the Mass Storage Class + * driver common defines, rather than being defined in the Host mode Class driver section only + * - The USB_MODE_HOST token is now defined even when host mode is not available + * - The CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport() HID Device Class driver callback now has a new ReportType parameter to + * indicate the report type to generate + * - All Class Drivers now return false or the "DeviceDisconnected" error code of their respective error enums when a function + * is called when no host/device is connected where possible + * - The HOST_SENDCONTROL_DeviceDisconnect enum value has been renamed to HOST_SENDCONTROL_DeviceDisconnected to be in line + * with the rest of the library error codes + * - Make MIDI device demos also turn off the on board LEDs if MIDI Note On messages are sent with a velocity of zero, + * which some devices use instead of Note Off messages (thanks to Robin Green) + * - The CDC demos are now named "VirtualSerial" instead to indicate the demos' function rather than its implemented USB class, + * to reduce confusion and to be in line with the rest of the LUFA demos + * - The SImage_Host_SendBlockHeader() and SImage_Host_ReceiveBlockHeader() Still Image Host Class driver functions are now public + * + * <b>Fixed:</b> + * - Added missing CDC_Host_CreateBlockingStream() function code to the CDC Host Class driver + * - Fixed incorrect values for REPORT_ITEM_TYPE_* enum values causing corrupt data in the HID Host Parser + * - Fixed misnamed SI_Host_USBTask() and SI_Host_ConfigurePipes() functions + * - Fixed broken USB_GetNextDescriptor() function causing the descriptor to jump ahead double the expected amount + * - Fixed Pipe_IsEndpointBound() not masking the given Endpoint Address against PIPE_EPNUM_MASK + * - Fixed host state machine not enabling Auto VBUS mode when HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS is set to zero + * - Fixed misnamed Pipe_SetPipeToken() macro for setting a pipe's direction + * - Fixed CDCHost failing on devices with bidirectional endpoints + * - Fixed USB driver failing to define the PLL prescaler mask for the ATMEGA8U2 and ATMEGA16U2 + * - Fixed HID Parser not distributing the Usage Min and Usage Max values across an array of report items + * - Fixed Mass Storage Host Class driver and Low Level demo not clearing the error condition if an attached device returns a + * STALL to a GET MAX LUN request (thanks to Martin Luxen) + * - Fixed TeensyHID bootloader not properly shutting down the USB interface to trigger a disconnection on the host before resetting + * - Fixed MassStorageHost Class driver demo not having USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS compile time option set properly to prevent slow + * devices from timing out the data pipes + * - Fixed the definition of the Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint() macro for the U4 series AVR parts + * - Fixed MIDI host Class driver MIDI_Host_SendEventPacket() routine not properly checking for Pipe ready before writing + * - Fixed use of deprecated struct initializers, removed library unused parameter warnings when compiled with -Wextra enabled + * - Fixed Still Image Host Class driver truncating the PIMA response code (thanks to Daniel Seibert) + * - Fixed USB_CurrentMode not being reset to USB_MODE_NONE when the USB interface is shut down and both Host and Device modes can be + * used (thanks to Daniel Levy) + * - Fixed TeensyHID bootloader not enumerating to the host correctly (thanks to Clint Fisher) + * - Fixed AVRISP project timeouts not checking for the correct timeout period (thanks to Carl Ott) + * - Fixed STK525 Dataflash driver using incorrect bit-shifting for Dataflash addresses (thanks to Tim Mitchell) + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog091122 Version 091122 + * + * <b>New:</b> + * - Added new Dual Role Keyboard/Mouse demo + * - Added new HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY compile time token to reduce the size of the HID Host Class driver when + * Report protocol is not needed + * - Added new MIDI LowLevel and ClassDriver Host demo, add new MIDI Host Class driver + * - Added new CDC/Mouse ClassDriver device demo + * - Added new Joystick Host ClassDriver and LowLevel demos + * - Added new Printer Host mode Class driver + * - Added new Printer Host mode ClassDriver demo + * - Added optional support for double banked endpoints and pipes in the Device and Host mode Class drivers + * - Added new stream creation function to the CDC Class drivers, to easily make standard I/O streams from CDC Class driver instances + * + * <b>Changed:</b> + * - Removed mostly useless "TestApp" demo, as it was mainly useful only for checking for syntax errors in the library + * - MIDI device demos now receive MIDI events from the host and display note ON messages via the board LEDs + * - Cleanups to the Device mode Mass Storage demo application SCSI routines + * - Changed Audio Class driver sample read/write functions to be inline, to reduce the number of cycles needed to transfer + * samples to and from the device (allowing more time for sample processing and output) + * - Audio class Device mode demos now work at both 16MHz and 8MHz, rather than just at 8MHz + * - The previous USBtoSerial demo has been moved into the projects directory, as it was just a modified CDC demo + * - The Endpoint/Pipe functions now use the const qualifier on the input buffer + * - Changed the CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem() callback to pass a HID_ReportItem_t rather than just the current + * item's attributes, to expose more information on the item (including it's type, collection path, etc.) + * - Changed MouseHostWithParser demos to check that the report items have a Mouse usage collection as a parent at some point, + * to prevent Joysticks from enumerating with the demo + * - Corrected the name of the misnamed USB_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor() function to USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(). + * - Keyboard LowLevel/ClassDriver demos now support multiple simultaneous key presses (up to 6) per report + * + * <b>Fixed:</b> + * - Fixed PrinterHost demo returning invalid Device ID data when the attached device does not have a + * device ID (thanks to Andrei Krainev) + * - Changed LUFA_VERSION_INTEGER define to use BCD values, to make comparisons easier + * - Fixed issue in the HID Host class driver's HID_Host_SendReportByID() routine using the incorrect mode (control/pipe) + * to send report to the attached device + * - Fixed ClassDriver AudioOutput device demo not selecting an audio output mode + * - Fixed incorrect SampleFrequencyType value in the AudioInput and AudioOutput ClassDriver demos' descriptors + * - Fixed incorrect event name rule in demo/project/bootloader makefiles + * - Fixed HID device class driver not reselecting the correct endpoint once the user callback routines have been called + * - Corrected HID descriptor in the Joystick Device demos - buttons should be placed outside the pointer collection + * - Fixed HID report parser collection paths invalid due to misplaced semicolon in the free path item search loop + * - Fixed HID host Class driver report send/receive report broken when issued through the control pipe + * - Fixed HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR compile time option being ignored when in host mode (thanks to David Lyons) + * - Fixed LowLevel Keyboard demo not saving the issues report only after it has been sent to the host + * - Fixed Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_* functions not sending a terminating IN when given data Length is zero + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog090924 Version 090924 + * + * <b>New:</b> + * - Added new host mode class drivers and matching demos to the library for rapid application development + * - Added flag to the HID report parser to indicate if a device has multiple reports + * - Added new EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame() event, controlled by the new USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents() and + * USB_Device_DisableSOFEvents() macros to give bus-synchronized millisecond interrupts when in USB device mode + * - Added new Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection() macro for bidirectional endpoints + * - Added new AVRISP project, a LUFA powered clone of the Atmel AVRISP-MKII programmer + * - Added ShutDown() functions for all hardware peripheral drivers, so that peripherals can be turned off after use + * - Added new CDC_Device_Flush() command to the device mode CDC Class driver to flush Device->Host data + * - Added extra masks to the SPI driver, changed SPI_Init() so that the clock polarity and sample modes can be set + * - Added new callback to the HID report parser, so that the user application can filter only the items it is interested + * in to be stored into the HIDReportInfo structure to save RAM + * - Added support for the officially recommended external peripheral layout for the BUMBLEB board (thanks to Dave Fletcher) + * - Added new Pipe_IsFrozen() macro to determine if the currently selected pipe is frozen + * - Added new USB_GetHIDReportSize() function to the HID report parser to retrieve the size of a given report by its ID + * - Added new combined Mass Storage and Keyboard demo (thanks to Matthias Hullin) + * + * <b>Changed:</b> + * - SetIdle requests to the HID device driver with a 0 idle period (send changes only) now only affect the requested + * HID interface within the device, not all HID interfaces + * - Added explicit attribute masks to the device mode demos' descriptors + * - Added return values to the CDC and MIDI class driver transmit functions + * - Optimized Endpoint_Read_Word_* and Pipe_Read_Word_* macros to reduce compiled size + * - Added non-null function parameter pointer restrictions to USB Class drivers to improve user code reliability + * - Added new "Common" section to the class drivers, to hold all mode-independent definitions for clarity + * - Moved SCSI command/sense constants into the Mass Storage Class driver, instead of the user-code + * - Altered the SCSI commands in the LowLevel Mass Storage Host to save on FLASH space by reducing function calls + * - Changed the parameters and behaviour of the USB_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor() function so that it now performs size checks + * and data validations internally, to simplify user code + * - Changed HIDParser to only zero out important values in the Parsed HID Report Item Information structure to save cycles + * - The HID report parser now always processed FEATURE items - HID_ENABLE_FEATURE_PROCESSING token now has no effect + * - The HID report parser now always ignores constant-data items, HID_INCLUDE_CONSTANT_DATA_ITEMS token now has no effect + * - The Benito Programmer project now has its own unique VID/PID pair allocated from the Atmel donated LUFA VID/PID pool + * - Add in new invalid event hook check targets to project makefiles to produce compilation errors when invalid event names + * are used in a project + * - The HID Report Parser now gives information on the total length of each report within a HID interface + * - The USE_NONSTANDARD_DESCRIPTOR_NAMES compile time token has been removed - there are now separate USB_Descriptor_* and + * USB_StdDescriptor_* structures for both the LUFA and standardized element naming conventions so both may be used + * + * <b>Fixed:</b> + * - Fixed possible lockup in the CDC device class driver, when the host sends data that is a multiple of the + * endpoint's bank + * - Fixed swapped parameters in the HID state memory copy call while processing a HID PUSH item in the HID report parser + * - Fixed memory corruption HID report parser when too many COLLECTION or PUSH items were processed + * - Fixed HID report parser not resetting the FEATURE item count when a REPORT ID item is encountered + * - Fixed USBtoSerial demos not reading in UDR1 when the USART receives data but the USB interface is not enumerated, + * causing continuous USART receive interrupts + * - Fixed misspelled event name in the Class driver USBtoSerial demo, preventing correct operation + * - Fixed invalid data being returned when a GetStatus request is issued in Device mode with an unhandled data recipient + * - Added hardware USART receive interrupt and software buffering to the Benito project to ensure received data is not + * missed or corrupted + * - Fixed Device mode HID Class driver always sending IN packets, even when nothing to report + * - Fixed Device mode HID Class driver not explicitly initializing the ReportSize parameter to zero before calling callback + * routine, so that ignored callbacks don't cause incorrect data to be sent + * - Fixed StillImageHost not correctly freezing and unfreezing data pipes while waiting for a response block header + * - Fixed error in the PrinterHost demo preventing the full page data from being sent to the attached device (thanks to John Andrews) + * - Fixed CDC based demos and projects' INF driver files under 64 bit versions of Windows (thanks to Ronny Hanson, Thomas Bleeker) + * - Re-add in missing flip, flip-ee, dfu and dfu-ee targets to project makefiles (thanks to Opendous Inc.) + * - Fix allowable F_CPU values comment in project makefiles to more accurately reflect the allowable values on the USB AVRs + * - Fixed DFU and CDC class bootloaders on the series 2 USB AVRs, corrected invalid signatures, added support for the new + * ATMEGAxx2 series 2 variant AVRs to the DFU bootloader + * - Fixed Low Level USBtoSerial demo not storing received characters (thanks to Michael Cooper) + * - Fixed MIDI Device Class driver not sending/receiving MIDI packets of the correct size (thanks to Thomas Bleeker) + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog090810 Version 090810 + * + * <b>New:</b> + * - Added new device class drivers and matching demos to the library for rapid application development + * - Added new PrinterHost demo (thanks to John Andrews) + * - Added USB Missile Launcher project, submitted by Dave Fletcher + * - Added new Benito Arduino Programmer project + * - Added incomplete device and host mode demos for later enhancement + * - Updated MassStorage device block write routines to use ping-pong Dataflash buffering to increase throughput by around 30% + * - Error status LEDs shown when device endpoint configuration fails to complete in all demos and projects + * - Added new USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration() convenience function for easy configuration selection of devices while in USB + * host mode + * - Added new USB_Host_ClearPipeStall() convenience function to clear a stall condition on an attached device's endpoint + * - Added new USB_Host_GetDeviceDescriptor() convenience function to retrieve the attached device's Device descriptor + * - Added new Endpoint_ClearStatusStage() convenience function to assist with the status stages of control transfers + * - Added new USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL define for using the unique serial numbers in some AVR models as the USB device's serial number, + * added NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL compile time option to turn off new serial number reading code + * - Added new DATAFLASH_CHIP_MASK() macro to the Dataflash driver, which returns the Dataflash select mask for the given chip index + * - Added new HOST_STATE_WaitForDeviceRemoval host state machine state for non-blocking disabling of device communications until the + * device has been removed (for use when an error occurs or communications with the device have completed) + * - Added new FAST_STREAM_TRANSFERS compile time option for faster stream transfers via multiple bytes copied per stream loop + * - Added stdio stream demo code to the CDC device demos, to show how to create standard streams out of the virtual serial ports + * - Added new EEPROM and FLASH buffer versions of the Endpoint and Pipe stream functions + * - Added new USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS and FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS compile time options + * - Added support for the new ATMEGA32U2, ATMEGA16U2 and ATMEGA8U2 AVR models + * - Added new USB_DeviceState variable to keep track of the current Device mode USB state + * - Added new LEDs_ToggleLEDs() function to the LEDs driver + * - Added new Pipe_BoundEndpointNumber() and Pipe_IsEndpointBound() functions + * - Added new DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR and HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR compile time options + * - Added 404 Not Found errors to the webserver in the RNDIS demos to indicate invalid URLs + * + * <b>Changed:</b> + * - Deprecated pseudo-scheduler and removed dynamic memory allocator from the library (first no longer needed and second unused) + * - The device-mode CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor() function now has an extra parameter so that the memory space in which the requested + * descriptor is located can be specified. This means that descriptors can now be located in multiple memory spaces within a device. + * - Removed vague USB_IsConnected global - test USB_DeviceState or USB_HostState explicitly to gain previous functionality + * - Removed USB_IsSuspended global - test USB_DeviceState against DEVICE_STATE_Suspended instead + * - Extended USB_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor() routine to require the configuration number within the device to fetch + * - Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy() now always ensures that the dataflash is ready for the next command immediately after returning, + * no need to call Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS() afterwards + * - Low level API MIDI device demo no longer blocks if a note change event is sent while the endpoint is not ready + * - Pipe_GetErrorFlags() now returns additional error flags for overflow and underflow errors + * - Pipe stream functions now automatically set the correct pipe token, so that bidirectional pipes can be used + * - Pipe_ConfigurePipe() now automatically defaults IN pipes to accepting infinite IN requests, this can still be changed by calling + * the existing Pipe_SetFiniteINRequests() function + * - Changed F_USB entries in project makefiles to alias to F_CPU by default, as this is the most common case + * - Host mode demos now use sane terminal escape codes, so that text is always readable and events/program output is visually distinguished + * from one another using foreground colours + * - Internal per-device preprocessing conditions changed to per-device series rather than per-controller group for finer-grain + * internal control + * - Interrupts are no longer disabled during the processing of Control Requests on the default endpoint while in device mode + * - AudioOutput demos now always output to board LEDs, regardless of output mode (removed AUDIO_OUT_LEDS project option) + * - Removed SINGLE_DEVICE_CONFIGURATION compile time option in favor of the new FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS option so that the exact number + * of device configurations can be defined statically + * - Removed VBUS events, as they are already exposed to the user application via the regular device connection and disconnection events + * - Renamed and altered existing events to properly separate out Host and Device mode events + * - All demos switched over from GNU99 standards mode to C99 standards mode, to reduce the dependencies on GCC-only language extensions + * + * <b>Fixed:</b> + * - Changed bootloaders to use FLASHEND rather than the existence of RAMPZ to determine if far FLASH pointers are needed to fix + * bootloaders on some of the USB AVR devices where avr-libc erroneously defines RAMPZ + * - Fixes to MassStorageHost for better device compatibility (increase command timeout, change MassStore_WaitForDataReceived() + * to only unfreeze and check one data pipe at a time) to prevent incorrect device enumerations and freezes while transferring data + * - Make Pipe_ConfigurePipe() mask the given endpoint number against PIPE_EPNUM_MASK to ensure the endpoint IN direction bit is + * cleared to prevent endpoint type corruption + * - Fixed issue opening CDC-ACM ports on hosts when the CDC device tries to send data before the host has set the line encoding + * - Fixed USB_OPT_MANUAL_PLL option being ignored during device disconnects on some models (thanks to Brian Dickman) + * - Fixed documentation mentioning Pipe_GetCurrentToken() function when correct function name is Pipe_GetPipeToken() + * - Fixed ADC driver for the ATMEGA32U4 and ATMEGA16U4 (thanks to Opendous Inc.) + * - Fixed CDCHost demo unfreezing the pipes at the point of configuration, rather than use + * - Fixed MassStorage demo not clearing the reset flag when a Mass Storage Reset is issued while not processing a command + * - Fixed USB_Host_SendControlRequest() not re-suspending the USB bus when initial device ready-wait fails + * - Fixed USB Pad regulator not being disabled on some AVR models when the USB_OPT_REG_DISABLED option is used + * - Fixed Host mode to Device mode UID change not causing a USB Disconnect event when a device was connected + * - Fixed Mouse/Keyboard demos not performing the correct arithmetic on the Idle period at the right times (thanks to Brian Dickman) + * - Fixed GenericHID failing HID class tests due to incorrect Logical Minimum and Logical Maximum values (thanks to Soren Greiner) + * - Fixed incorrect PIPE_EPNUM_MASK mask causing pipe failures on devices with endpoint addresses of 8 and above (thanks to John Andrews) + * - Fixed report data alignment issues in the MouseHostWithParser demo when X and Y movement data size is not a multiple of 8 bits + * - Fixed HID Report Descriptor Parser not correctly resetting internal states when a REPORT ID element is encountered + * - Fixed incorrect BUTTONS_BUTTON1 for the STK526 target + * - Fixed RNDIS demos freezing when more than one connection was attempted simultaneously, causing memory corruption + * - Fixed USBtoSerial demo receiving noise from the USART due to pull-up not being enabled + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog090605 Version 090605 + * + * - Fixed bug in RNDISEthernet and DualCDC demos not using the correct USB_ControlRequest structure for control request data + * - Fixed documentation showing incorrect USB mode support on the supported AVRs list + * - Fixed RNDISEthernet not working under Linux due to Linux requiring an "optional" RNDIS request which was unhandled + * - Fixed Mouse and Keyboard device demos not acting in accordance with the HID specification for idle periods (thanks to Brian Dickman) + * - Removed support for endpoint/pipe non-control interrupts; these did not act in the way users expected, and had many subtle issues + * - Fixed Device Mode not handling Set Feature and Clear Feature Chapter 9 requests that are addressed to the device (thanks to Brian Dickman) + * - Moved control endpoint interrupt handling into the library itself, enable via the new INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT token + * - Fixed CDCHost not clearing configured pipes and resetting configured pipes mask when a partially enumerated invalid CDC + * interface is skipped + * - Clarified the size of library tokens which accept integer values in the Compile Time Tokens page, values now use the smallest datatype + * inside the library that is able to hold their defined value to save space + * - Removed DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS() macro as it was largely superfluous and only served to obfuscate code + * - Rewritten event system to remove all macros, to make user code clearer + * - Fixed incorrect ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK mask preventing endpoints above EP3 from being selected (thanks to Jonathan Oakley) + * - Removed STREAM_CALLBACK() macro - callbacks now use regular function definitions to clarify user code + * - Removed DESCRIPTOR_COMPARATOR() macro - comparators should now use regular function definitions to clarify user code + * - USB_IsConnected is now cleared before the USB_Disconnect() event is fired in response to VBUS being removed + * - Fixed incorrect PID value being used in the USBtoSerial project (thanks to Phill) + * - Deleted StdDescriptors.c, renamed USB_GetDescriptor() to CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor, moved ConfigDescriptor.c/.h from the + * LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/ directory to LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/ in preparation for the new USB class APIs + * - Moved out each demos' functionality library files (e.g. Ring Buffer library) to /Lib directories for a better directory structure + * - Removed Tx interrupt from the USBtoSerial demo; now sends characters via polling to ensure more time for the Rx interrupt + * - Fixed possible enumeration errors from spin-loops which may fail to exit if the USB connection is severed before the exit condition + * becomes true + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog090510 Version 090510 + * + * - Added new GenericHIDHost demo + * - Corrections to the KeyboardHost and MouseHost demos' pipe handling to freeze and unfreeze the data pipes at the point of use + * - KeyboardHost, MouseHost and GenericHIDHost demos now save and restore the currently selected pipe inside the pipe ISR + * - Changed GenericHID device demo to use the LUFA scheduler, added INTERRUPT_DATA_ENDPOINT and INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT compile + * time options + * - All comments in the library, bootloaders, demos and projects have now been spell-checked and spelling mistakes/typos corrected + * - Added new PIMA_DATA_SIZE() define to the Still Image Host demo + * - Add call to MassStore_WaitForDataReceived() in MassStore_GetReturnedStatus() to ensure that the CSW has been received in the + * extended MSC timeout period before continuing, to prevent long processing delays from causing the MassStore_GetReturnedStatus() + * to early-abort (thanks to Dmitry Maksimov) + * - Move StdRequestType.h, StreamCallbacks.h, USBMode.h from the LowLevel USB driver directory to the HighLevel USB driver directory, + * where they are more suited + * - Removed all binary constants and replaced with decimal or hexadecimal constants so that unpatched GCC compilers can still build the + * code without having to be itself patched and recompiled first + * - Added preprocessor checks and documentation to the bootloaders giving information about missing SIGNATURE_x defines due to + * outdated avr-libc versions. + * - Added support to the CDCHost demo for devices with multiple CDC interfaces which are not the correct ACM type preceding the desired + * ACM CDC interface + * - Fixed GenericHID demo not starting USB and HID management tasks when not using interrupt driven modes (thanks to Carl Kjeldsen) + * - Fixed RNDISEthenet demo checking the incorrect message field for packet size constraints (thanks to Jonathan Oakley) + * - Fixed WriteNextReport code in the GenericHIDHost demo using incorrect parameter types and not selecting the correct endpoint + * - Adjusted sample CTC timer calculations in the AudioOutput and AudioInput demos to match the CTC calculations in the AVR datasheet, + * and to fix instances where rounding caused the endpoint to underflow (thanks to Robin Theunis) + * - The USB_Host_SendControlRequest() function no longer automatically selects the Control pipe (pipe 0), so that other control type + * pipes can be used with the function + * - The USB Host management task now saves and restores the currently selected pipe before and after the task completes + * - Fixed GenericHIDHost demo report write routine incorrect for control type requests (thanks to Andrei Krainev) + * - Removed Endpoint_ClearCurrentBank() and Pipe_ClearCurrentBank() in favor of new Endpoint_ClearIN(), Endpoint_ClearOUT(), + * Pipe_ClearIN() and Pipe_ClearOUT() macros (done to allow for the detection of packets of zero length) + * - Renamed *_ReadWriteAllowed() macros to *_IsReadWriteAllowed() to remain consistent with the rest of the LUFA API + * - Endpoint_IsSetupReceived() macro has been renamed to Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived(), Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived() macro has been + * renamed to Endpoint_ClearSETUP(), the Pipe_IsSetupSent() macro has been renamed to Pipe_IsSETUPSent() and the + * Pipe_ClearSetupSent() macro is no longer applicable and should be removed - changes made to compliment the new endpoint and pipe + * bank management API + * - Updated all demos, bootloaders and projects to use the new endpoint and pipe management APIs (thanks to Roman Thiel from Curetis AG) + * - Updated library Doxygen documentation, added groups, changed documentation macro functions to real functions for clarity + * - Removed old endpoint and pipe aliased read/write/discard routines which did not have an explicit endian specifier for clarity + * - Removed the ButtLoadTag.h header file, as no one used for its intended purpose anyway + * - Renamed the main Drivers/AT90USBXXX directory to Drivers/Peripheral, renamed the Serial_Stream driver to SerialStream + * - Fixed CDC and USBtoSerial demos freezing where buffers were full while still transmitting or receiving (thanks to Peter Hand) + * - Removed "Host_" section of the function names in ConfigDescriptor.h, as most of the routines can now be used in device mode on the + * device descriptor + * - Renamed functions in the HID parser to have a "USB_" prefix and the acronym "HID" in the name + * - Fixed incorrect HID interface class and subclass values in the Mouse and KeyboardMouse demos (thanks to Brian Dickman) + * - Capitalized the "Descriptor_Search" and "Descriptor_Search_Comp" prefixes of the values in the DSearch_Return_ErrorCodes_t and + * DSearch_Comp_Return_ErrorCodes_t enums + * - Removed "ERROR" from the enum names in the endpoint and pipe stream error code enums + * - Renamed the USB_PowerOnErrorCodes_t enum to USB_InitErrorCodes_t, renamed the POWERON_ERROR_NoUSBModeSpecified enum value to + * USB_INITERROR_NoUSBModeSpecified + * - Renamed USB_PowerOnFail event to USB_InitFailure + * - Renamed OTG.h header functions to be more consistent with the rest of the library API + * - Changed over all deprecated GCC structure tag initializers to the standardized C99 format (thanks to Mike Alexander) + * - USB_HostRequest renamed to USB_ControlRequest, entire control request header is now read into USB_ControlRequest in Device mode + * rather than having the library pass only partially read header data to the application + * - The USB_UnhandledControlPacket event has had its parameters removed, in favor of accessing the new USB_ControlRequest structure + * - The Endpoint control stream functions now correctly send a ZLP to the host when less data than requested is sent + * - Fixed USB_RemoteWakeupEnabled flag never being set (the REMOTE WAKEUP Set Feature request was not being handled) + * - Renamed the FEATURELESS_CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE compile-time token to CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + * - Endpoint configuration is now refined to give better output when all configurations have static inputs - removed the now useless + * STATIC_ENDPOINT_CONFIGURATION compile time token + * - Fixed SPI driver init function not clearing SPI2X bit when not needed + * - Fixed PREVENT ALLOW MEDIUM REMOVAL command issuing in the MassStorageHost demo using incorrect parameters (thanks to Mike Alex) + * - Fixed MassStorageHost demo broken due to an incorrect if statement test in MassStore_GetReturnedStatus() + * - Fixed reversed signature byte ordering in the CDC bootloader (thanks to Johannes Raschke) + * - Changed PIPE_CONTROLPIPE_DEFAULT_SIZE from 8 to 64 to try to prevent problems with faulty devices which do not respect the given + * wLength value when reading in the device descriptor + * - Fixed missing semicolon in the ATAVRUSBRF01 LED board driver code (thanks to Morten Lund) + * - Changed LED board driver code to define dummy LED masks for the first four board LEDs, so that user code can be compiled for boards + * with less than four LEDs without code modifications (thanks to Morten Lund) + * - Changed HWB board driver to Buttons driver, to allow for the support of future boards with more than one mounted GPIO button + * - Serial driver now correctly calculates the baud register value when in double speed mode + * - Init function of the Serial driver is now static inline to product smaller code for the common-case of static init values + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog090401 Version 090401 + * + * - Fixed MagStripe project configuration descriptor containing an unused (blank) endpoint descriptor + * - Incorporated makefile changes by Denver Gingerich to retain compatibility with stock (non-WinAVR) AVR-GCC installations + * - Fixed makefile EEPROM programming targets programming FLASH data in addition to EEPROM data + * - LUFA devices now enumerate correctly with LUFA hosts + * - Fixed Configuration Descriptor search routine freezing when a comparator returned a failure + * - Removed HID report item serial dump in the MouseHostWithParser and KeyboardHostWithParser - useful only for debugging, and + * slowed down the enumeration of HID devices too much + * - Increased the number of bits per track which can be read in the MagStripe project to 8192 when compiled for the AT90USBXXX6/7 + * - Fixed KeyboardMouse demo discarding the wIndex value in the REQ_GetReport request + * - USBtoSerial demo now discards all Rx data when not connected to a USB host, rather than buffering characters for transmission + * next time the device is attached to a host. + * - Added new F_USB compile time constant to the library and makefiles, to give the raw input clock (used to feed the PLL before any + * clock prescaling is performed) frequency, so that the PLL prescale mask can be determined + * - Changed stream wait timeout counter to be 16-bit, so that very long timeout periods can be set for correct communications with + * badly designed hosts or devices which greatly exceed the USB specification limits + * - Mass Storage Host demo now uses a USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS of two seconds to maintain compatibility with poorly designed devices + * - Function attribute ATTR_ALWAYSINLINE renamed to ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE to match other function attribute macro naming conventions + * - Added ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE attribute to several key inlined library components, to ensure they are inlined in all circumstances + * - Removed SetSystemClockPrescaler() macro, the clock_prescale_set() avr-libc macro has been corrected in recent avr-libc versions + * - Fixed incorrect/missing control status stage transfers on demos, bootloaders and applications (thanks to Nate Lawson) + * - The NO_CLEARSET_FEATURE_REQUEST compile time token has been renamed to FEATURELESS_CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE, and its function expanded + * to also remove parts of the Get Status chapter 9 request to further reduce code usage + * - Makefile updated to include output giving the currently selected BOARD parameter value + * - Board Dataflash driver now allows for dataflash ICs which use different shifts for setting the current page/byte address (thanks + * to Kenneth Clubb) + * - Added DataflashManager_WriteBlocks_RAM() and DataflashManager_ReadBlocks_RAM() functions to the MassStorage demo, to allow for easy + * interfacing with a FAT library for dataflash file level access + * - Corrected CDC class bootloader to fix a few bugs, changed address counter to store x2 addresses for convenience + * - Fixed typos in the SPI driver SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_64 and SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_128 masks (thanks to Markus Zocholl) + * - Keyboard and Mouse device demos (normal, data interrupt and fully interrupt driven) combined into unified keyboard and mouse demos + * - Keyboard and Mouse host demos (normal and data interrupt driven) combined into unified keyboard and mouse demos + * - Removed AVRISP_Programmer project due to code quality concerns + * - Fixed CDC demo not sending an empty packet after each transfer to prevent the host from buffering incoming data + * - Fixed documentation typos and preprocessor checks relating to misspellings of the USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS token (thanks to Ian Gregg) + * - Fixed USBTask.h not conditionally including HostChapter9.h only when USB_CAN_BE_HOST is defined (thanks to Ian Gregg) + * - Fixed incorrect ADC driver init register manipulation (thanks to Tobias) + * - Added new GenericHID device demo application + * - Fixed Still Image Host SImage_SendData() function not clearing the pipe bank after sending data + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog090209 Version 090209 + * + * - PWM timer mode in AudioOut demo changed to Fast PWM for speed + * - Updated Magstripe project to work with the latest hardware revision + * - Fixed library not responding to the BCERRI flag correctly in host mode, leading to device lockups + * - Fixed library handling Get Descriptor requests when not addressed as standard requests to the device or interface (thanks to + * Nate Lawson) + * - Fixed serious data corruption issue in MassStorage demo dataflash write routine + * - Added new NO_CLEARSET_FEATURE_REQUEST compile time token + * - USB task now restores previous global interrupt state after execution, rather than forcing global interrupts to be enabled + * - Fixed USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event firing after each configuration change, rather than once after the initial configuration + * - Added ENDPOINT_DOUBLEBANK_SUPPORTED() macros to Endpoint.h, altered ENDPOINT_MAX_SIZE() to allow user to specify endpoint + * - ENDPOINT_MAX_ENDPOINTS changed to ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS, PIPE_MAX_PIPES changed to PIPE_TOTAL_PIPES + * - Endpoint and Pipe non-control stream functions now ensure endpoint or pipe is ready before reading or writing + * - Changed Teensy bootloader to use a watchdog reset when exiting rather than a software jump + * - Fixed integer promotion error in MassStorage and MassStorageHost demos, corrupting read/write transfers + * - SPI_SendByte is now SPI_TransferByte, added new SPI_SendByte and SPI_ReceiveByte functions for fast one-way transfer + * - MassStorage demo changed to use new fast one-way SPI transfers to increase throughput + * - MassStorage handling of Mass Storage Reset class request improved + * - Altered MassStorage demo dataflash block read code for speed + * - Added USB_IsSuspended global flag + * - Simplified internal Dual Mode (OTG) USB library code to reduce code size + * - Extended stream timeout period to 100ms from 50ms + * - Mass Storage Host demo commands now all return an error code from the Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum + * - Added SubErrorCode parameter to the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event + * - VBUS drop interrupt now disabled during the manual-to-auto VBUS delivery handoff + * - Simplified low level backend so that device/host mode initialization uses the same code paths + * - Added workaround for faulty Mass Storage devices which do not implement the required GET_MAX_LUN request + * - Removed buggy Telnet application from the RNDIS demo + * - Moved Mass Storage class requests in the Mass Storage Host demo to wrapper functions in MassStoreCommands.c + * - Fixed incorrect SCSI command size value in the Request Sense command in MassStoreCommands.c + * - Added SetProtocol request to HID class non-parser Mouse and Keyboard demos to force devices to use the correct Boot Protocol + * - Added new "dfu" and "flip" programming targets to project makefiles + * - HID_PARSE_Sucessful enum member typo corrected to HID_PARSE_Successful + * - Changed COLLECTION item structures in the HID descriptor parser to include the collection's Usage Page value + * - Serial driver now sets Tx line as output, enables pull-up on Rx line + * - Fixed smaller USB AVRs raising multiple connection and disconnection events when NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT is disabled + * - Added HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS to give the host delay after a device is connected before it is enumerated + * - Fixed KeyboardHostWithParser demo linking against the wrong global variables + * - Completed doxygen documentation of remaining library bootloaders, demos and projects + * - Fixed incorrect bootloader start address in the TeensyHID bootloader + * - Added HWB button whole-disk ASCII dump functionality to MassStoreHost demo + * - Replaced printf_P(PSTR("%c"), {Variable}) calls with putchar(<Variable>) for speed and size savings + * - Serial driver now accepts baud rates over 16-bits in size, added double speed flag option + * - Fixed incorrect callback abort return value in Pipe.c + * - Added new flip-ee and dfu-ee makefile targets (courtesy of Opendous Inc.) + * - Removed reboot-on-disconnect code from the TeensyHID bootloader, caused problems on some systems + * - Fixed AudioOutput and AudioInput demos looping on the endpoint data, rather than processing a sample at a time and returning + * each time the task runs to allow for other tasks to execute + * - Added support for the Atmel ATAVRUSBRF01 board + * - Added AVRISP Programmer Project, courtesy of Opendous Inc. + * - Fixed CDC Host demo not searching through both CDC interfaces for endpoints + * - Fixed incorrect Product String descriptor length in the DFU class bootloader + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog081224 Version 081224 + * + * - MyUSB name changed to LUFA, the Lightweight USB Framework for AVRs + * - Fixed Mass Storage Host demo's MassStore_SendCommand() delay in the incorrect place + * - Fixed USBtoSerial demo not calling ReconfigureUSART() after a change in the line encoding + * - Fixed infinite loop in host mode Host-to-Device control transfers with data stages + * - HID report parser now supports devices with multiple reports in one interface via Report IDs + * - Fixed RZUSBSTICK board LED driver header incorrect macro definition order causing compile errors + * - Calling USB_Init() when the USB interface is already configured now forces a complete interface reset + * and re-enumeration - fixes MyUSB DFU bootloader not switching to app code correctly when soft reset used + * - Fixed "No newline at end of file" warning when stream callbacks are enabled + * - DFU bootloader now uses fixed signature bytes per device, rather than reading them out dynamically for size + * - Added new FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE and USE_SINGLE_DEVICE_CONFIGURATION switches to statically define certain values to + * reduce compiled binary size + * - Added new NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT switch to prevent the library from trying to determine bus connection + * state from the suspension and wake up events on the smaller USB AVRs + * - Added summary of all library compile time tokens to the documentation + * - Added overview of the LUFA scheduler to the documentation + * - Removed MANUAL_PLL_CONTROL compile time token, replaced with a mask for the USB_Init() Options parameter + * - CDC bootloader now uses the correct non-far or far versions of the pgm_* functions depending on if RAMPZ is defined + * - Doxygen documentation now contains documentation on all the projects, bootloaders and most demos included with the library + * - CDC bootloader now runs user application when USB disconnected rather than waiting for a hard reset + * - MouseHostWithParser and KeyboardHostWithParser now support multiple-report devices + * - RNDIS demo can now close connections correctly using the new TCP_APP_CLOSECONNECTION() macro - used in Webserver + * - Fixed the DFU bootloader, no longer freezes up when certain files are programmed into an AVR, made reading/writing faster + * - Fixed mouse/joystick up/down movements reversed - HID mouse X/Y coordinates use a left-handed coordinate system, not a normal + * right-handed system + * - Added stub code to the CDC and USBtoSerial demos showing how to read and set the RS-232 handshake lines - not currently used in + * the demos, but the example code and supporting defines are now in place + * - Interrupts are now disabled when processing a control request in device mode, to avoid exceeding the strict control request + * timing requirements. + * - All demos now use a central StatusUpdate() function rather than direct calls to the board LED functions, so that the demos can + * easily be altered to show different LED combinations (or do something else entirely) as the demo's status changes + * - Removed LED commands from the CDC bootloader, unused by most AVR910 programming software + * - Fixed RNDIS demo ICMP ping requests echoing back incorrect data + * - Added DHCP server code to RNDIS demo, allowing for hands-free auto configuration on any PC + * - Fixed DFU bootloader PID value for the ATMEGA16U4 AVR + * - Endpoint and Pipe configuration functions now return an error code indicating success or failure + * - USB Reset in device mode now resets and disables all device endpoints + * - Added intermediate states to the host mode state machine, reducing the USB task blocking time to no more than 1ms explicitly per + * invocation when in host mode + * - Added support for the ATMEGA32U6 microcontroller + * - Added STATIC_ENDPOINT_CONFIGURATION compile time option, enabled in the bootloaders to minimize space usage + * - Removed redundant code from the USB device GetStatus() chapter 9 processing routine + * - Added new TeensyHID bootloader, compatible with the Teensy HID protocol (http://www.pjrc.com/teensy/) + * - Versions are now numbered by release dates, rather than arbitrary major/minor revision numbers + * - USB_RemoteWakeupEnabled is now correctly set and cleared by SetFeature and ClearFeature requests from the host + * - Changed prototype of GetDescriptor, so that it now returns the descriptor size (or zero if the descriptor doesn't exist) + * rather than passing the size back to the caller through a parameter and returning a boolean + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog153 Version 1.5.3 (081002) + * + * - Fixed CDC bootloader using pgmspace macros for some descriptors inappropriately + * - Updated all Mouse and Keyboard device demos to include boot protocol support (now works in BIOS) + * - Renamed bootloader directories to remove spaces, which were causing build problems on several OSes + * - Removed serial number strings from all but the MassStore demo where it is required - users were not + * modifying the code to either omit the descriptor or use a unique serial per device causing problems + * when multiple units of the same device were plugged in at the same time + * - AudioOutput and AudioInput demos now correctly silence endpoints when not enabled by the host + * - Added KeyboardMouse demo (Keyboard and Mouse functionality combined into a single demo) + * - Added DriverStubs directory to house board level driver templates, to make MyUSB compatible custom board + * driver creation easier + * - Extended MassStorage demo to support multiple LUNs, 2 by default + * - Fixed incorrect device address mask, preventing the device from enumerating with addresses larger than 63 + * - Fixed incorrect data direction mask in the GetStatus standard request, preventing it from being handled + * - Fixed incorrect GetStatus standard request for endpoints, now returns the endpoint STALL status correctly + * - Added in new USB_RemoteWakeupEnabled and USB_CurrentlySelfPowered flags rather than using fixed values + * - Added DualCDC demo to demonstrate the use of Interface Association Descriptors + * - Added pipe NAK detection and clearing API + * - Added pipe status change (NAK, STALL, etc.) interrupt API + * - Fixed MassStorageHost demo so that it no longer freezes randomly when issuing several commands in a row + * - Host demos configuration descriptor routines now return a unique error code when the returned data does + * not have a valid configuration descriptor header + * - Added Endpoint_WaitUntilReady() and Pipe_WaitUntilReady() functions + * - Stream functions now have software timeouts, timeout period can be set by the USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS token + * - All demos now pass the USB.org automated Chapter 9 device compliance tests + * - All HID demos now pass the USB.org automated HID compliance tests + * - Polling interval of the interrupt endpoint in the CDC based demos changed to 0xFF to fix problems on Linux systems + * - Changed stream functions to accept a new callback function, with NO_STREAM_CALLBACKS used to disable all callbacks + * - Mass Storage demo Dataflash management routines changed to use the endpoint stream functions + * - Added AVRStudio project files for each demo in addition to the existing Programmer's Notepad master project file + * - Re-added call to ReconfigureUSART() in USBtoSerial SetLineCoding request, so that baud rate changes + * are reflected in the hardware (change was previously lost) + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog152 Version 1.5.2 (080731) + * + * - Fixed SwapEndian_32() function in Common.h so that it now works correctly (wrong parameter types) + * - Updated RNDIS demo - notification endpoint is no longer blocking so that it works with faulty Linux RNDIS + * implementations (where the notification endpoint is ignored in favor of polling the control endpoint) + * - Fixed incorrect Vendor Description string return size in RNDIS demo for the OID_GEN_VENDOR_DESCRIPTION OID token + * - Added very basic TCP/IP stack and HTTP/TELNET servers to RNDIS demo + * - Fixed DFU bootloader exit causing programming software to complain about failed writes + * - Fixed DFU bootloader EEPROM programming mode wiping first flash page + * - Fixed Clear/Set Feature device standard request processing code (fixing MassStorage demo in the process) + * - Added support for the ATMEGA16U4 AVR microcontroller + * - Library license changed from LGPLv3 to MIT license + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog151 Version 1.5.1 (080707) + * + * - Changed host demos to enable the host function task on the firing of the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event + * rather than the USB_DeviceAttached event + * - HID Usage Stack now forcefully cleared after an IN/OUT/FEATURE item has been completely processed to remove + * any referenced but not created usages + * - Changed USB_INT_DisableAllInterrupts() and USB_INT_ClearAllInterrupts(), USB_Host_GetNextDescriptorOfType(), + * USB_Host_GetNextDescriptorOfTypeBefore(), USB_Host_GetNextDescriptorOfTypeAfter() to normal functions (from inline) + * - Fixed USBtoSerial demo not sending data, only receiving + * - Fixed main makefile to make all by default, fixed MagStripe directory case to prevent case-sensitive path problems + * - ConfigDescriptor functions made normal, instead of static inline + * - Pipe/Endpoint *_Ignore_* functions changed to *_Discard_*, old names still present as aliases + * - Fixed ENDPOINT_MAX_SIZE define to be correct on limited USB controller AVRs + * - Changed endpoint and pipe size translation routines to use previous IF/ELSE IF cascade code, new algorithmic + * approach was buggy and caused problems + * - Bootloaders now compile with -fno-inline-small-functions option to reduce code size + * - Audio demos now use correct endpoint sizes for full and limited controller USB AVRs, double banking in all cases + * to be in line with the specification (isochronous endpoints MUST be double banked) + * - Added Interface Association descriptor to StdDescriptors.h, based on the relevant USB2.0 ECN + * - Fixed MIDI demo, corrected Audio Streaming descriptor to follow the MIDI-specific AS structure + * - Fixed HID class demo descriptors so that the HID interface's protocol is 0x00 (required for non-boot protocol HID + * devices) to prevent problems on hosts expecting the boot protocol functions to be supported + * - Added read/write control stream functions to Endpoint.h + * - Fixed AudioOut demo not setting port pins to inputs on USB disconnect properly + * - Added RNDISEthernet demo application + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog150 Version 1.5.0 (080610) + * + * - Fixed MIDI demo, now correctly waits for the endpoint to be ready between multiple note messages + * - Added CDC Host demo application + * - Added KeyboardFullInt demo application + * - Endpoint and Pipe creation routines now mask endpoint/pipe size with the size mask, to remove transaction + * size bits not required for the routines (improves compatibility with devices) + * - Fixed AudioInput demo - now correctly sends sampled audio to the host PC + * - Fixed AudioOutput demo once more -- apparently Windows requires endpoint packets to be >=192 bytes + * - Shrunk round-robin scheduler code slightly via the use of struct pointers rather than array indexes + * - Fixed off-by-one error when determining if the Usage Stack is full inside the HID Report parser + * - Renamed Magstripe.h to MagstripeHW.h and moved driver out of the library and into the MagStripe demo folder + * - Added preprocessor checks to enable C linkage on the library components when used with a C++ compiler + * - Added Still Image Host demo application + * - The USB device task now restores the previously selected endpoint, allowing control requests to be transparently + * handled via interrupts while other endpoints are serviced through polling + * - Fixed device signature being sent in reverse order in the CDC bootloader + * - Host demos now have a separate ConfigDescriptor.c/.h file for configuration descriptor processing + * - HostWithParser demos now have a separate HIDReport.c/.h file for HID report processing and dumping + * - Removed non-mandatory commands from MassStorage demo to save space, fixed SENSE ResponseCode value + * - CDC demos now send empty packets after sending a full one to prevent buffering issues on the host + * - Updated demo descriptors to use VID/PID values donated by Atmel + * - Added DoxyGen documentation to the source files + * - Fixed Serial_IsCharReceived() definition, was previously reversed + * - Removed separate USB_Descriptor_Language_t descriptor, USB_Descriptor_String_t is used instead + * - Removed unused Device Qualifier descriptor structure + * - Renamed the USB_CreateEndpoints event to the more appropriate USB_ConfigurationChanged + * - Fixed MassStorageHost demo reading in the block data in reverse + * - Removed outdated typedefs in StdRequestType.h, superseded by the macro masks + * - Corrected OTG.h is now included when the AVR supports both Host and Device modes, for creating OTG products + * - USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event is now also fired when in device mode and the host has finished its enumeration + * - Interrupt driven demos now properly restore previously selected endpoint when ISR is complete + * - The value of USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS can now be overridden in the user project makefile to a custom fixed timeout value + * - Renamed USB_Host_SOFGeneration_* macros to more friendly USB_Host_SuspendBus(), USB_Host_ResumeBus() + * and USB_Host_IsBusSuspended() + * - Renamed *_*_Is* macros to *_Is* to make all flag checking macros consistent, Pipe_SetInterruptFreq() is now + * Pipe_SetInterruptPeriod() to use the correct terminology + * - UnicodeString member of USB_Descriptor_String_t struct changed to an ordinary int array type, so that the GCC + * Unicode strings (prefixed with an L before the opening quotation mark) can be used instead of explicit arrays + * of ASCII characters + * - Fixed Endpoint/Pipes being configured incorrectly if the maximum endpoint/pipe size for the selected USB AVR + * model was given as the bank size + * - HID device demos now use a true raw array for the HID report descriptor rather than a struct wrapped array + * - Added VERSION_BCD() macro, fixed reported HID and USB version numbers in demo descriptors + * - Cleaned up GetDescriptor device chapter 9 handler function + * - Added GET_REPORT class specific request to HID demos to make them complaint to the HID class + * - Cleaned up setting of USB_IsInitialized and USB_IsConnected values to only when needed + * - Removed Atomic.c and ISRMacro.h; the library was already only compatible with recent avr-lib-c for other reasons + * - All demos and library functions now use USB standardized names for the USB data (bRequest, wLength, etc.) + * - Added USE_NONSTANDARD_DESCRIPTOR_NAMES token to switch back to the non-standard descriptor element names + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog141 Version 1.4.1 (090519) + * + * - Enhanced KeyboardWithParser demo, now prints out pressed alphanumeric characters like the standard demo + * - Fixed MassStorage demo, read/writes using non mode-10 commands now work correctly + * - Corrected version number in Version.h + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog140 Version 1.4.0 (090505) + * + * - Added HID Report Parser API to the library + * - Added Mouse and Keyboard host demo applications, using the new HID report parser engine + * - Added MouseFullInt demo, which demonstrates a fully interrupt (including control requests) mouse device + * - Fixed incorrect length value in the audio control descriptor of the AudioOutput and AudioInput demos + * - Added MIDI device demo application to the library + * - Fixed problem preventing USB devices from being resumed from a suspended state + * - Added new CDC class bootloader to the library, based on the AVR109 bootloader protocol + * - Added header to each demo application indicating the mode, class, subclass, standards used and supported speed + * - Functions expecting endpoint/pipe numbers are no longer automatically masked against ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK or + * PIPE_PIPENUM_MASK - this should be manually added to code which requires it + * - Fixed DFU class bootloader - corrected frequency of flash page writes, greatly reducing programming time + * - Renamed AVR_HOST_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor() to USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor() and AVR_HOST_GetNextDescriptor() + * to USB_Host_GetNextDescriptor() + * - Added new USB_Host_GetNextDescriptorOfTypeBefore() and USB_Host_GetNextDescriptorOfTypeAfter() routines + * - Moved configuration descriptor routines to MyUSB/Drivers/USB/Class/, new accompanying ConfigDescriptors.c file + * - Added new configuration descriptor comparator API for more powerful descriptor parsing, updated host demos to use the + * new comparator API + * - Fixed MassStorageHost demo capacity printout, and changed data read/write mode from little-endian to the correct + * big-endian for SCSI devices + * - Fixed macro/function naming consistency; USB_HOST is now USB_Host, USB_DEV is now USB_Device + * - Added better error reporting to host demos + * - Added 10 microsecond delay after addressing devices in host mode, to prevent control stalls + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog132 Version 1.3.2 (080401) + * + * - Added call to ReconfigureUSART() in USBtoSerial SetLineCoding request, so that baud rate changes + * are reflected in the hardware + * - Fixed CDC and USBtoSerial demos - Stream commands do not work for control endpoints, and the + * GetLineCoding request had an incorrect RequestType mask preventing it from being processed + * - Improved reliability of the USBtoSerial demo, adding a busy wait while the buffer is full + * - Device control endpoint size is now determined from the device's descriptors rather than being fixed + * - Separated out SPI code into new SPI driver in AT90USBXXX driver directory + * - Bootloader now returns correct PID for the selected USB AVR model, not just the AT90USB128X PID + * - Added support for the RZUSBSTICK board + * - Bicolour driver removed in favor of generic LEDs driver + * - Added support for the ATMEGA32U4 AVR + * - Added MANUAL_PLL_CONTROL compile time option to prevent the USB library from manipulating the PLL + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog131 Version 1.3.1 (080319) + * + * - Fixed USB to Serial demo - class value in the descriptors was incorrect + * - Control endpoint size changed from 64 bytes to 8 bytes to save on USB FIFO RAM and to allow low + * speed mode devices to enumerate properly + * - USB to Serial demo data endpoints changed to dual-banked 16 byte to allow the demo to work + * on USB AVRs with limited USB FIFO RAM + * - Changed demo endpoint numbers to use endpoints 3 and 4 for double banking, to allow limited + * USB device controller AVRs (AT90USB162, AT90USB82) to function correctly + * - Updated Audio Out demo to use timer 1 for AVRs lacking a timer 3 for the PWM output + * - Fixed incorrect USB_DEV_OPT_HIGHSPEED entry in the Mass Storage device demo makefile + * - Optimized Mass Storage demo for a little extra transfer speed + * - Added LED indicators to the Keyboard demo for Caps Lock, Num Lock and Scroll Lock + * - Added Endpoint_Read_Stream, Endpoint_Write_Stream, Pipe_Read_Stream and Pipe_Write_Stream functions + * (including Big and Little Endian variants) + * - Made Dataflash functions inline for speed, removed now empty Dataflash.c driver file + * - Added new SetSystemClockPrescaler() macro (thanks to Joerg Wunsch) + * - Fixed Endpoint_ClearStall() to function correctly on full USB controller AVRs (AT90USBXXX6/7) + * - Endpoint_Setup_In_Clear() and Endpoint_Setup_Out_Clear() no longer set FIFOCON, in line with the + * directives in the datasheet + * - Fixed PLL prescaler defines for all AVR models and frequencies + * - Fixed ENDPOINT_INT_IN and ENDPOINT_INT_OUT definitions + * - Added interrupt driven keyboard and mouse device demos + * - Combined USB_Device_ClearFeature and USB_Device_SetFeature requests into a single routine for code + * size savings + * - Added missing Pipe_GetCurrentPipe() macro to Pipe.h + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog130 Version 1.3.0 (080307) + * + * - Unnecessary control endpoint config removed from device mode + * - Fixed device standard request interpreter accidentally processing some class-specific requests + * - Added USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS and USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS compile time options to instruct the library + * to use descriptors stored in RAM or EEPROM rather than flash memory + * - All demos now disable watchdog on startup, in case it has been enabled by fuses or the bootloader + * - USB_DEV_OPT_LOWSPEED option now works correctly + * - Added ability to set the USB options statically for a binary size reduction via the USE_STATIC_OPTIONS + * compile time define + * - USB_Init no longer takes a Mode parameter if compiled for a USB device with no host mode option, or + * if forced to a particular mode via the USB_HOST_ONLY or USB_DEVICE_ONLY compile time options + * - USB_Init no longer takes an Options parameter if options statically configured by USE_STATIC_OPTIONS + * - Endpoint_Ignore_* and Pipe_Ignore_* made smaller by making the dummy variable non-volatile so that the + * compiler can throw away the result more efficiently + * - Added in an optional GroupID value to each scheduler entry, so that groups of tasks can once again be + * controlled by the new Scheduler_SetGroupTaskMode() routine + * - Added support for AT90USB162 and AT90USB82 AVR models + * - Added support for the STK525 and STK526 boards + * - Added support for custom board drivers to be supplied by selecting the board type as BOARD_USER, and + * placing board drivers in {Application Directory}/Board/ + * - PLL is now stopped and USB clock is frozen when detached from host in device mode, to save power + * - Joystick defines are now in sync with the schematics - orientation will be rotated for the USBKEY + * - Fixed USB_DEV_IsUSBSuspended() - now checks the correct register + * - Fixed data transfers to devices when in host mode + * - Renamed USB_DEV_OPT_HIGHSPEED to USB_DEV_OPT_FULLSPEED and USB_HOST_IsDeviceHighSpeed() to + * USB_HOST_IsDeviceFullSpeed() to be in line with the official USB speed names (to avoid confusion with + * the real high speed mode, which is unavailable on the USB AVRs) + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog120 Version 1.2.0 (080204) + * + * - Added USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event for host mode + * - Added new Scheduler_Init routine to prepare the scheduler, so that tasks can be started and + * stopped before the scheduler has been started (via Scheduler_Start) + * - Connection events in both Device and Host mode are now interrupt-driven, allowing the USB management + * task to be stopped when the USB is not connected to a host or device + * - All demos updated to stop the USB task when not in use via the appropriate USB events + * - Mass Storage Host demo application updated to function correctly with all USB flash disks + * - Mass Storage Host demo application now prints out the capacity and number of LUNs in the attached + * device, and prints the first block as hexadecimal numbers rather than ASCII characters + * - Endpoint and Pipe clearing routines now clear the Endpoint/Pipe interrupt and status flags + * - Shifted error handling code in the host enum state machine to a single block, to reduce code complexity + * - Added in DESCRIPTOR_TYPE, DESCRIPTOR_SIZE and DESCRIPTOR_CAST macros to make config descriptor processing + * clearer in USB hosts and DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS for convenience in USB devices + * - Added in alloca macro to common.h, in case the user is using an old version of avr-lib-c missing the macro + * + * + * \section Sec_ChangeLog110 Version 1.1.0 (080125) + * + * - Fixed DCONNI interrupt being enabled accidentally after a USB reset + * - Fixed DDISCI interrupt not being disabled when a device is not connected + * - Added workaround for powerless pull-up devices causing false disconnect interrupts + * - Added USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event for Host mode + * - AVR_HOST_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor routine no longer modifies ConfigSizePtr if a valid buffer + * pointer is passed + * - Added ALLOCABLE_BYTES to DynAlloc, and added code to make the size of key storage variables + * dependent on size of memory parameters passed in via the user project's makefile + * - Fixed incorrect device reset routine being called in USBTask + * - Devices which do not connect within the standard 300mS are now supported + * - Removed incorrect ATTR_PURE from Scheduler_SetTaskMode(), which was preventing tasks from being + * started/stopped, as well as USB_InitTaskPointer(), which was breaking dual device/host USB projects + * - Changed scheduler to use the task name rather than IDs for setting the task mode, eliminating the + * need to have a task ID list + * - ID transition interrupt now raises the appropriate device/host disconnect event if device attached + * - Fixed double VBUS change (and VBUS -) event when detaching in device mode + * - Added ability to disable ANSI terminal codes by the defining of DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES in makefile + * - Removed return from ConfigurePipe and ConfigureEndpoint functions - use Pipe_IsConfigured() and + * Endpoint_IsConfigured() after calling the config functions to determine success + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/CompileTimeTokens.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/CompileTimeTokens.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..92adf0dccf --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/CompileTimeTokens.txt @@ -0,0 +1,223 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \page Page_TokenSummary Summary of Compile Tokens + * + * The following lists all the possible tokens which can be defined in a project makefile, and passed to the + * compiler via the -D switch, to alter the LUFA library code. These tokens may alter the library behaviour, + * or remove features unused by a given application in order to save flash space. + * + * \note If the \c USE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER token is defined, the library will include a header file named \c LUFAConfig.h located + * in the user directory where the below compile time tokens may be defined. This allows for an alternative to makefile + * defined tokens for configuring the library. + * + * \section Sec_TokenSummary_NonUSBTokens Non USB Related Tokens + * This section describes compile tokens which affect non-USB sections of the LUFA library. + * + * \li <b>DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES</b> - (\ref Group_Terminal) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * If an application contains ANSI terminal control codes listed in TerminalCodes.h, it might be desired to remove them + * at compile time for use with a terminal which is non-ANSI control code aware, without modifying the source code. If + * this token is defined, all ANSI control codes in the application code from the TerminalCodes.h header are removed from + * the source code at compile time. + * + * + * \section Sec_TokenSummary_USBClassTokens USB Class Driver Related Tokens + * This section describes compile tokens which affect USB class-specific drivers in the LUFA library. + * + * \li <b>HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY</b> - (\ref Group_USBClassHIDHost) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * By default, the USB HID Host class driver is designed to work with HID devices using either the Boot or Report HID + * communication protocols. On devices where the Report protocol is not used (i.e. in applications where only basic + * Mouse or Keyboard operation is desired, using boot compatible devices), the code responsible for the Report protocol + * mode can be removed to save space in the compiled application by defining this token. When defined, it is still necessary + * to explicitly put the attached device into Boot protocol mode via a call to \ref HID_Host_SetBootProtocol(). + * + * \li <b>HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH</b>=<i>x</i> - (\ref Group_HIDParser) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * HID reports may contain PUSH and POP elements, to store and retrieve the current HID state table onto a stack. This + * allows for reports to save the state table before modifying it slightly for a data item, and then restore the previous + * state table in a compact manner. This token may be defined to a non-zero 8-bit value to give the maximum depth of the state + * table stack. If not defined, this defaults to the value indicated in the HID.h file documentation. + * + * \li <b>HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH</b>=<i>x</i> - (\ref Group_HIDParser) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * HID reports generally contain many USAGE elements, which are assigned to INPUT, OUTPUT and FEATURE items in succession + * when multiple items are defined at once (via REPORT COUNT elements). This allows for several items to be defined with + * different usages in a compact manner. This token may be defined to a non-zero 8-bit value to set the maximum depth of the + * usage stack, indicating the maximum number of USAGE items which can be stored temporarily until the next INPUT, OUTPUT + * and FEATURE item. If not defined, this defaults to the value indicated in the HID.h file documentation. + * + * \li <b>HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS</b>=<i>x</i> - (\ref Group_HIDParser) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * HID reports generally contain several COLLECTION elements, used to group related data items together. Collection information + * is stored separately in the processed usage structure (and referred to by the data elements in the structure) to save space. + * This token may be defined to a non-zero 8-bit value to set the maximum number of COLLECTION items which can be processed by the + * parser into the resultant processed report structure. If not defined, this defaults to the value indicated in the HID.h file + * documentation. + * + * \li <b>HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS</b>=<i>x</i> - (\ref Group_HIDParser) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * All HID reports contain one or more INPUT, OUTPUT and/or FEATURE items describing the data which can be sent to and from the HID + * device. Each item has associated usages, bit offsets in the item reports and other associated data indicating the manner in which + * the report data should be interpreted by the host. This token may be defined to a non-zero 8-bit value to set the maximum number of + * data elements which can be stored in the processed HID report structure, including INPUT, OUTPUT and (if enabled) FEATURE items. + * If a item has a multiple count (i.e. a REPORT COUNT of more than 1), each item in the report count is placed separately in the + * processed HID report table. If not defined, this defaults to the value indicated in the HID.h file documentation. + * + * \li <b>HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS</b>=<i>x</i> - (\ref Group_HIDParser) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * HID reports may contain several report IDs, to logically distinguish grouped device data from one another - for example, a combination + * keyboard and mouse might use report IDs to separate the keyboard reports from the mouse reports. In order to determine the size of each + * report, and thus know how many bytes must be read or written, the size of each report (IN, OUT and FEATURE) must be calculated and + * stored. This token may be defined to a non-zero 8-bit value to set the maximum number of report IDs in a device which can be processed + * and their sizes calculated/stored into the resultant processed report structure. If not defined, this defaults to the value indicated in + * the HID.h file documentation. + * + * \li <b>NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH</b> - (\ref Group_USBClassDrivers) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * Many of the device and host mode class drivers automatically flush any data waiting to be written to an interface, when the corresponding + * USB management task is executed. This is usually desirable to ensure that any queued data is sent as soon as possible once and new data is + * constructed in the main program loop. However, if flushing is to be controlled manually by the user application via the *_Flush() commands, + * the compile time token may be defined in the application's makefile to disable automatic flushing during calls to the class driver USB + * management tasks. + * + * + * \section Sec_TokenSummary_USBTokens General USB Driver Related Tokens + * This section describes compile tokens which affect USB driver stack as a whole in the LUFA library. + * + * \li <b>ORDERED_EP_CONFIG</b> - (\ref Group_EndpointManagement , \ref Group_PipeManagement) - <i>AVR8, UC3</i> \n + * The USB AVRs do not allow for Endpoints and Pipes to be configured out of order; they <i>must</i> be configured in an ascending order to + * prevent data corruption issues. However, by default LUFA employs a workaround to allow for unordered Endpoint/Pipe initialization. This compile + * time token may be used to restrict the initialization order to ascending indexes only in exchange for a smaller compiled binary size. Use + * caution when applied to applications using the library USB Class drivers; the user application must ensure that all endpoints and pipes are + * allocated sequentially. + * + * \li <b>USE_STATIC_OPTIONS</b>=<i>x</i> - (\ref Group_USBManagement) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * By default, the USB_Init() function accepts dynamic options at runtime to alter the library behaviour, including whether the USB pad + * voltage regulator is enabled, and the device speed when in device mode. By defining this token to a mask comprised of the USB options + * mask defines usually passed as the Options parameter to USB_Init(), the resulting compiled binary can be decreased in size by removing + * the dynamic options code, and replacing it with the statically set options. When defined, the USB_Init() function no longer accepts an + * Options parameter. + * + * \li <b>USB_DEVICE_ONLY</b> - (\ref Group_USBManagement) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * For the USB AVR models supporting both device and host USB modes, the USB_Init() function contains a Mode parameter which specifies the + * mode the library should be initialized to. If only device mode is required, the code for USB host mode can be removed from the binary to + * save space. When defined, the USB_Init() function no longer accepts a Mode parameter. This define is irrelevant on smaller USB AVRs which + * do not support host mode. + * + * \li <b>USB_HOST_ONLY</b> - (\ref Group_USBManagement) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * Same as USB_DEVICE_ONLY, except the library is fixed to USB host mode rather than USB device mode. Not available on some USB AVR models. + * + * \li <b>USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS</b>=<i>x</i> - (\ref Group_USBManagement) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * When endpoint and/or pipe stream functions are used, by default there is a timeout between each transfer which the connected device or host + * must satisfy, or the stream function aborts the remaining data transfer. This token may be defined to a non-zero 16-bit value to set the timeout + * period for stream transfers, specified in milliseconds. If not defined, the default value specified in LowLevel.h is used instead. + * + * \li <b>NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT</b> - (\ref Group_Events) - <i>AVR8 Only</i> \n + * On the smaller USB AVRs, the USB controller lacks VBUS events to determine the physical connection state of the USB bus to a host. In lieu of + * VBUS events, the library attempts to determine the connection state via the bus suspension and wake up events instead. This however may be + * slightly inaccurate due to the possibility of the host suspending the bus while the device is still connected. If accurate connection status is + * required, the VBUS line of the USB connector should be routed to an AVR pin to detect its level, so that the \ref USB_DeviceState global + * can be accurately set and the \ref EVENT_USB_Device_Connect() and \ref EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect() events manually raised by the user application. + * When defined, this token disables the library's auto-detection of the connection state by the aforementioned suspension and wake up events. + * + * \li <b>NO_SOF_EVENTS</b> - (\ref Group_Events) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * By default, there exists a LUFA application event for the start of each USB frame while the USB bus is not suspended in either host or device mode. + * This event can be selectively enabled or disabled by calling the appropriate device or host mode function. When this compile time token is defined, + * the ability to receive USB Start of Frame events via the \ref EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame() or \ref EVENT_USB_Host_StartOfFrame() events is removed, + * reducing the compiled program's binary size. + * + * + * \section Sec_TokenSummary_USBDeviceTokens USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens + * This section describes compile tokens which affect USB driver stack of the LUFA library when used in Device mode. + * + * \li <b>USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS</b> - (\ref Group_StdDescriptors) - <i>AVR8 Only</i> \n + * Define this token to indicate to the USB driver that all device descriptors are stored in RAM, rather than being located in any one + * of the AVR's memory spaces. RAM descriptors may be desirable in applications where the descriptors need to be modified at runtime. + * + * \li <b>USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS</b> - (\ref Group_StdDescriptors) - <i>AVR8 Only</i> \n + * Similar to USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS, but all descriptors are stored in the AVR's FLASH memory rather than RAM. + * + * \li <b>USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS</b> - (\ref Group_StdDescriptors) - <i>AVR8 Only</i> \n + * Similar to USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS, but all descriptors are stored in the AVR's EEPROM memory rather than RAM. + * + * \li <b>NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL</b> - (\ref Group_StdDescriptors) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * Some AVR models contain a unique serial number which can be used as the device serial number, while in device mode. This allows + * the host to uniquely identify the device regardless of if it is moved between USB ports on the same computer, allowing allocated + * resources (such as drivers, COM Port number allocations) to be preserved. This is not needed in many apps, and so the code that + * performs this task can be disabled by defining this option and passing it to the compiler via the -D switch. + * + * \li <b>FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE</b>=<i>x</i> - (\ref Group_EndpointManagement) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * By default, the library determines the size of the control endpoint (when in device mode) by reading the device descriptor. + * Normally this reduces the amount of configuration required for the library, allows the value to change dynamically (if + * descriptors are stored in EEPROM or RAM rather than flash memory) and reduces code maintenance. However, this token can be + * defined to a non-zero value instead to give the size in bytes of the control endpoint, to reduce the size of the compiled + * binary. + * + * \li <b>DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR</b> - (\ref Group_Device) - <i>AVR8 Only</i> \n + * One of the most frequently used global variables in the stack is the USB_DeviceState global, which indicates the current state of + * the Device State Machine. To reduce the amount of code and time required to access and modify this global in an application, this token + * may be defined to a value between 0 and 2 to fix the state variable into one of the three general purpose IO registers inside the AVR + * reserved for application use. When defined, the corresponding GPIOR register should not be used within the user application except + * implicitly via the library APIs. + * + * \li <b>FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS</b>=<i>x</i> - (\ref Group_Device) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * By default, the library determines the number of configurations a USB device supports by reading the device descriptor. This reduces + * the amount of configuration required to set up the library, and allows the value to change dynamically (if descriptors are stored in + * EEPROM or RAM rather than flash memory) and reduces code maintenance. However, this value may be fixed via this token in the project + * makefile to reduce the compiled size of the binary at the expense of flexibility. + * + * \li <b>CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE</b> - (\ref Group_Device) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * In some limited USB device applications, there are no device endpoints other than the control endpoint; i.e. all device communication + * is through control endpoint requests. Defining this token will remove several features related to the selection and control of device + * endpoints internally, saving space. Generally, this is usually only useful in (some) bootloaders and is best avoided. + * + * \li <b>MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX</b> - (\ref Group_Device) - <i>XMEGA Only</i> \n + * Defining this value to the highest index (not address - this excludes the direction flag) endpoint within the device will restrict the + * number of FIFOs created internally for the endpoint buffers, reducing the total RAM usage. + * + * \li <b>INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT</b> - (\ref Group_USBManagement) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * Some applications prefer to not call the USB_USBTask() management task regularly while in device mode, as it can complicate code significantly. + * Instead, when device mode is used this token can be passed to the library via the -D switch to allow the library to manage the USB control + * endpoint entirely via USB controller interrupts asynchronously to the user application. When defined, USB_USBTask() does not need to be called + * when in USB device mode. + * + * \li <b>NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP</b> - (\ref Group_Device) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * Many devices do not require the use of the Remote Wakeup features of USB, used to wake up the USB host when suspended. On these devices, + * the code required to manage device Remote Wakeup can be disabled by defining this token and passing it to the library via the -D switch. + * + * \li <b>NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER</b> - (\ref Group_Device) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * USB devices may be bus powered, self powered, or a combination of both. When a device can be both bus powered and self powered, the host may + * query the device to determine the current power source, via \ref USB_Device_CurrentlySelfPowered. For solely bus powered devices, this global + * and the code required to manage it may be disabled by passing this token to the library via the -D switch. + * + * + * \section Sec_TokenSummary_USBHostTokens USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens + * + * This section describes compile tokens which affect USB driver stack of the LUFA library when used in Host mode. + * + * \li <b>HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR</b> - (\ref Group_Host) - <i>AVR8 Only</i> \n + * One of the most frequently used global variables in the stack is the USB_HostState global, which indicates the current state of + * the Host State Machine. To reduce the amount of code and time required to access and modify this global in an application, this token + * may be defined to a value between 0 and 2 to fix the state variable into one of the three general purpose IO registers inside the AVR + * reserved for application use. When defined, the corresponding GPIOR register should not be used within the user application except + * implicitly via the library APIs. + * + * \li <b>USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS</b>=<i>x</i> - (\ref Group_Host) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * When a control transfer is initiated in host mode to an attached device, a timeout is used to abort the transfer if the attached + * device fails to respond within the timeout period. This token may be defined to a non-zero 16-bit value to set the timeout period for + * control transfers, specified in milliseconds. If not defined, the default value specified in Host.h is used instead. + * + * \li <b>HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS</b>=<i>x</i> - (\ref Group_Host) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * Some devices require a delay of up to 5 seconds after they are connected to VBUS before the enumeration process can be started, or + * they will fail to enumerate correctly. By placing a delay before the enumeration process, it can be ensured that the bus has settled + * back to a known idle state before communications occur with the device. This token may be defined to a 16-bit value to set the device + * settle period, specified in milliseconds. If not defined, the default value specified in Host.h is used instead. + * + * \li <b>INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE</b> - (\ref Group_Host) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * If enabled, this will indicate that the USB target VBUS line polarity is inverted; i.e. it should be pulled low to enable VBUS to the + * target, and pulled high to stop the target VBUS generation. + * \n + * \attention On AVR8 architecture devices, this compile time option requires \c NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT to be set. + * + * \li <b>NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT</b> - (\ref Group_Host) - <i>All Architectures</i> \n + * Disables the automatic management of VBUS to the target, i.e. automatic shut down in the even of an overcurrent situation. When enabled, VBUS + * is enabled while the USB controller is initialized in USB Host mode. + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/CompilingApps.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/CompilingApps.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..08f81d2ba2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/CompilingApps.txt @@ -0,0 +1,46 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \page Page_CompilingApps Compiling the Demos, Bootloaders and Projects + * + * The following details how to compile the included LUFA demos, applications and bootloaders using AVR-GCC. + * + * \section Sec_CompilingApps_Prerequisites Prerequisites + * Before you can compile any of the LUFA library code or demos, you will need a recent distribution of avr-libc (1.6.2+) + * and the AVR-GCC (4.2+) compiler. A standard "coreutils" package for your system is also required for command line + * compilation of LUFA based applications. + * + * \subsection SSec_CompilingApps_PreqWindows Windows Prerequisites + * On Windows, you will need a copy of the latest Atmel Toolchain (<a>http://www.atmel.com/tools/ATMELAVRTOOLCHAINFORWINDOWS.aspx</a>), + * either downloaded and installed as a standalone package, or installed as part of Atmel Studio. You will need to ensure + * that the "bin" directory of the toolchain is available in your system's <b>PATH</b> environment variable. + * + * In addition, you will need to install a ported version of the ZSH or BASH *nix shells, and a standard set of *nix + * utilities such as <i>cut</i>, <i>find</i> and <i>sed</i>. These can be found in the "basic" system package of the + * of the MinGW installer (<a>http://www.mingw.org</a>). Once installed, add the "msys\1.0\bin" of the MinGW installation + * folder is added to your system's <b>PATH</b> environment variable. + * + * \subsection SSec_CompilingApps_PreqLinux Linux Prerequisites + * On Linux systems you will need to install the latest Linux distribution of the standalone Atmel Toolchain from the + * Atmel website (<a>http://www.atmel.com/tools/ATMELAVRTOOLCHAINFORLINUX.aspx</a>), or use the latest avr-libc and avr-gcc packages + * for your chosen distribution's package manager. For full device support, the Atmel standalone Toolchain package is recommended. + * + * \section Sec_CompilingApps_Compiling Compiling a LUFA Application + * Compiling the LUFA demos, applications and/or bootloaders is very simple. LUFA comes with makefile scripts for + * each individual demo, bootloader and project folder, as well as scripts in the Demos/, Bootloaders/, Projects/ + * and the LUFA root directory. Compilation of projects can be started from any of the above directories, with a build + * started from an upper directory in the directory structure executing build of all child directories under it. This + * means that while a build inside a particular demo directory will build only that particular demo, a build started from + * the /Demos/ directory will build all LUFA demo projects sequentially. + * + * To build a project from the source via the command line, the command <b>"make all"</b> should be executed from the command + * line in the directory of interest. To remove compiled files (including the binary output, all intermediately files and all + * diagnostic output files), execute <b>"make clean"</b>. Once a "make all" has been run and no errors were encountered, the + * resulting binary will be located in the generated ".HEX" file. If your project makes use of pre-initialized EEPROM + * variables, the generated ".EEP" file will contain the project's EEPROM data. + * + * \see \ref Page_BuildSystem for information on the LUFA build system. + */ diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/ConfiguringApps.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/ConfiguringApps.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..15b660e927 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/ConfiguringApps.txt @@ -0,0 +1,157 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \page Page_ConfiguringApps Configuring the Demos, Bootloaders and Projects + * + * If the target microcontroller model, architecture, clock speed, board or other settings are different from the current + * settings, they must be changed and the project recompiled from the source code before being programmed into the microcontroller. + * Most project configuration options are located in the <tt>makefile</tt> build script inside each LUFA application's folder, + * however some demo or application-specific configuration settings are located in one or more of the source files of the project. + * See each project's individual documentation for application-specific configuration values. + * + * Each project "makefile" contains all the script and configuration data required to compile each project. When opened with + * any regular basic text editor such as Notepad or WordPad (ensure that the save format is a pure ASCII text format) the + * build configuration settings may be altered. + * + * \see \ref Page_BuildSystem for information on the LUFA build system. + * + * \section Sec_ConfiguringApps_AppMakefileParams The Default Application Makefile Template + * + * Below is a copy of the default LUFA application makefile, which can be used as a template for each application. + * + * \verbinclude makefile_template + * + * Inside each makefile, a number of configuration variables are listed with the syntax "<VARIABLE NAME> = <VALUE>". For + * each application, the important standard variables which should be altered are: + * + * - <b>MCU</b>, the target processor model + * - <b>ARCH</b>, the target microcontroller architecture + * - <b>BOARD</b>, the target board hardware + * - <b>F_CPU</b>, the target CPU master clock frequency, after any prescaling + * - <b>F_USB</b>, the target raw input clock to the USB module of the processor + * - <b>OPTIMIZATION</b>, the level of optimization to compile with + * - <b>TARGET</b>, the name of the target output binary and other files + * - <b>SRC</b>, the list of source files to compile/assemble/link + * - <b>LUFA_PATH</b>, the path to the LUFA library core source code + * - <b>CC_FLAGS</b>, the common command line flags to pass to the C/C++ compiler, assembler and linker + * - <b>LD_FLAGS</b>, the command line flags to pass to the linker + * + * These values should be changed to reflect the build hardware. + * + * \subsection SSec_ConfiguringApps_MCU The MCU Parameter + * This parameter indicates the target microcontroller model for the compiled application. This should be set to the model of the target + * microcontroller (such as the AT90USB1287, or the ATMEGA32U4), in all lower-case (e.g. "at90usb1287"). Note that not all demos support all the + * microcontroller models and architectures, as they may make use of peripherals or modes only present in some devices. + * + * For supported processor models, see \ref Page_DeviceSupport. + * + * \subsection SSec_ConfiguringApps_ARCH The ARCH Parameter + * This parameter indicates the target microcontroller architecture the library is to be compiled for. Different microcontroller + * architectures require different source files to be compiled into the final binary, and so this option must be set to the correct + * architecture for the selected platform. + * + * For supported processor architectures, see \ref Page_DeviceSupport. + * + * \subsection SSec_ConfiguringApps_BOARD The BOARD Parameter + * This parameter indicates the target board hardware for the compiled application. Some LUFA library drivers are board-specific, + * such as the LED driver, and the library needs to know the layout of the target board. If you are using one of the board models listed + * on the main library page, change this parameter to the board name in all UPPER-case. + * + * If you are not using any board-specific drivers in the LUFA library, or you are using a custom board layout, change this to read + * "USER" (no quotes) instead of a standard board name. If the USER board type is selected and the application makes use of one or more + * board-specific hardware drivers inside the LUFA library, then the appropriate stub drives files should be copied from the \c /CodeTemplates/DriverStubs/ + * directory into a /Board/ folder inside the application directory, and the stub driver completed with the appropriate code to drive the + * custom board's hardware. + * + * For boards with built in hardware driver support within the LUFA library, see \ref Page_DeviceSupport. + * + * \subsection SSec_ConfiguringApps_F_CPU The F_CPU Parameter + * This parameter indicates the target microcontroller's main CPU clock frequency, in Hz. This is used by many libraries (and applications) for + * timing related purposes, and should reflect the actual CPU speed after any prescaling or adjustments are performed. + * + * \subsection SSec_ConfiguringApps_F_USB The F_USB Parameter + * This parameter indicates the raw input clock frequency to the USB module within the microcontroller in Hz. This may be very different on some platforms + * to the main CPU clock or other peripheral/bus clocks. + * + * \note On AVR8 platforms, this must be equal to \c 8000000 or \c 16000000. + * + * \note On XMEGA platforms, this must be equal to a multiple of 6000000 from \c 6000000 to \c 48000000. + * + * \note On UC3 platforms, this must be equal to a multiple of 12000000 from \c 12000000 to \c 48000000. + * + * \subsection SSec_ConfiguringApps_OPTIMIZATION The OPTIMIZATION Parameter + * This parameter indicates the level of optimization to use when compiling the application. This will allow you to compile with an optimization level + * supported by GCC, from <tt>0</tt> (no optimization) to <tt>3</tt> (fastest runtime optimization) or <tt>s</tt> (smallest size). + * + * \subsection SSec_ConfiguringApps_TARGET The TARGET Parameter + * This parameter indicates the application target name, which is used as the base filename for the build binary and debugging files. This will be the + * name of the output files once linked together into the final application, ready to load into the target. + * + * \subsection SSec_ConfiguringApps_SRC The SRC Parameter + * This parameter indicates the source files used to compile the application, as a list of C (<tt>*.c</tt>), C++ (<tt>*.cpp</tt>) and Assembly (<tt>*.S</tt>) files. Note that + * all assembly files must end in a <b>capital</b> .S extension, as lowercase .s files are reserved for GCC intermediate files. + * + * \subsection SSec_ConfiguringApps_LUFA_PATH The LUFA_PATH Parameter + * As each LUFA program requires the LUFA library source code to compile correctly, the application must know where the LUFA library is located. This + * value specifies the path to the LUFA library core. This path may be relative or absolute, however note than even under Windows based systems the + * forward-slash (/) path separator must be used. + * + * \subsection SSec_ConfiguringApps_CC_FLAGS The CC_FLAGS Parameter + * This parameter lists the compiler flags passed to the C/C++ compiler, the assembler and the linker. These are used as-is directly to GCC and thus + * must match GCC's command line options as given in the GCC manual. This variable may be used to define tokens directly on the command line, enable or + * disable warnings, adjust the target-specific tuning parameters or other options. + * + * \subsection SSec_ConfiguringApps_LD_FLAGS The LD_FLAGS Parameter + * This parameter lists the linker flags passed exclusively to the linker. These are used as-is directly to GCC and thus must match GCC's command line + * linker options as given in the GCC manual. This variable may be used to create or relocate custom data sections, or enable linker specific behaviors. + * + * + * \section Sec_ExampleAppConfig Example Application Makefile Configurations + * Below is an example makefile for an AVR8 based AT90USB1287 running at 8MHz, to compile a program called "MyApplication": + * \verbatim + MCU = at90usb1287 + ARCH = AVR8 + BOARD = NONE + F_CPU = 8000000 + F_USB = $(F_CPU) + OPTIMIZATION = s + TARGET = MyApplication + SRC = MyApplication.c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) + LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA + CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ + LD_FLAGS = + \endverbatim + * + * Below is an example makefile for an XMEGA based ATXMEGA128A1U running at 32MHz, to compile a program called "MyApplication": + * \verbatim + MCU = atxmega128a1u + ARCH = XMEGA + BOARD = NONE + F_CPU = 32000000 + F_USB = 48000000 + OPTIMIZATION = s + TARGET = MyApplication + SRC = MyApplication.c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) + LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA + CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ + LD_FLAGS = + \endverbatim + * + * Below is an example makefile for a UC3 based AT32UC3A0512 running at 50MHz, to compile a program called "MyApplication": + * \verbatim + MCU = uc3a0512 + ARCH = UC3 + BOARD = NONE + F_CPU = 50000000 + F_USB = 48000000 + OPTIMIZATION = s + TARGET = MyApplication + SRC = MyApplication.c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) + LUFA_PATH = ../../../../LUFA + CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ + LD_FLAGS = + \endverbatim + */ diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/DevelopingWithLUFA.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/DevelopingWithLUFA.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..31b58fa2af --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/DevelopingWithLUFA.txt @@ -0,0 +1,23 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** + * \page Page_DevelopingWithLUFA Developing With LUFA + * + * This section of the manual contains information on LUFA development, such as Getting Started information, + * information on compile-time tuning of the library and other developer-related sections. + * + * <b>Subsections:</b> + * \li \subpage Page_BuildSystem - The LUFA Buildsystem + * \li \subpage Page_TokenSummary - Summary of Compile Time Tokens + * \li \subpage Page_Migration - Migrating from an Older LUFA Version + * \li \subpage Page_VIDPID - Allocated USB VID and PID Values + * \li \subpage Page_OSDrivers - Operating System Driver Information + * \li \subpage Page_BuildLibrary - Building as a Linkable Library + * \li \subpage Page_WritingBoardDrivers - How to Write Custom Board Drivers + * \li \subpage Page_SoftwareBootloaderStart - How to jump to the bootloader in software + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/DeviceSupport.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/DeviceSupport.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cff2cda4b9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/DeviceSupport.txt @@ -0,0 +1,424 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** + * \page Page_DeviceSupport Device and Hardware Support + * + * <b>Atmel Microcontrollers:</b> + * \li \subpage Page_AVR8Support - Atmel AVR8 Support + * \li \subpage Page_UC3Support - Atmel AVR32 UC3 Support + * \li \subpage Page_XMEGASupport - Atmel XMEGA Support + */ + +/** + * \page Page_AVR8Support Atmel 8-Bit AVR (AVR8) Support + * + * \section Sec_AVR8Support_Devices Supported Microcontroller Models + * + * Currently supported AVR8 models: + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th width="150px">Part</th> + * <th width="150px">USB Device Mode</th> + * <th width="150px">USB Host Mode</th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT90USB82</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATMEGA8U2</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT90USB162</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATMEGA16U2</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATMEGA16U4</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATMEGA32U2</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATMEGA32U4</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT90USB646</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT90USB647</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT90USB1286</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT90USB1287</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_AVR8Support_Boards Supported Atmel Boards + * Currently supported Atmel AVR8 boards (see \ref Group_BoardTypes): + * - AT90USBKEY + * - ATAVRUSBRF01 + * - EVK527 + * - RZUSBSTICK + * - STK525 + * - STK526 + * - XPLAIN (Original green board, <i>not</i> the newer blue XPLAINED family boards) + * - Xplained-MINI + * + * \section Sec_AVR8Support_ThirdParty Supported Third Party Boards + * Currently supported third-party boards (see \ref Group_BoardTypes for makefile \c BOARD constant names): + * - Adafruit U4 Breakout Board + * - Arduino Leonardo + * - Arduino Micro + * - Arduino Uno + * - Arduino Yun + * - Bitwizard Multio and Big-Multio + * - Busware BUI + * - Busware CUL V3 + * - Busware TUL + * - DorkbotPDX Duce + * - Fletchtronics Bumble-B (using manufacturer recommended peripheral layout) + * - Kernel Concepts USBFOO + * - Linnix UDIP + * - MattairTech JM-DB-U2 + * - Maximus USB + * - Micropendous Boards (Micropendous-32U2, Micropendous-1, Micropendous-2) + * - Microsin AVR-USB162 + * - Minimus USB + * - Olimex AVR-USB-162, AVR-USB-32U4 and AVR-USB-T32U4 Boards + * - Olimex AVR-ISP-MK2 + * - Paranoid Studio's US2AX (V1, V2 and V3 hardware revisions) + * - PJRC Teensy (1.x and 2.x versions) + * - Pololu A-Star Micro + * - Rikus' U2S + * - Sparkfun U2 Breakout Board + * - Stange ISP Programmer Board + * - TCNISO Blackcat USB JTAG + * - Tempusdictum Benito + * - Tom's USBTINY-MKII (all revisions and versions) + * - Custom User Boards (with Board Drivers if desired, see \ref Page_WritingBoardDrivers) + */ + +/** + * \page Page_UC3Support Atmel 32-Bit UC3 AVR (UC3) + * + * \warning The AVR32 UC3 device support is currently <b>experimental</b>, and is included for preview purposes only. + * + * \section Sec_UC3Support_Devices Supported Microcontroller Models + * + * Currently supported UC3 models: + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th width="150px">Part</th> + * <th width="150px">USB Device Mode</th> + * <th width="150px">USB Host Mode</th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3A364</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3A364S</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3A464</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3A464S</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3B064</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3B164</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3A0128</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3A1128</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3A3128</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3A3128S</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3A4128</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3A4128S</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3B0128</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3B1128</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3A0256</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3A1256</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3A3256</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3A3256S</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3A4256</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3A4256S</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3B0256</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3B1256</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3A0512</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3A1512</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3B0512</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AT32UC3B1512</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_UC3Support_Boards Supported Atmel Boards + * + * Currently supported Atmel UC3 boards (see \ref Group_BoardTypes): + * - EVK1100 + * - EVK1101 + * - EVK1104 + * - UC3-A3 Xplained + * + * \section Sec_UC3Support_ThirdParty Supported Third Party Boards + * + * Currently supported third-party boards (see \ref Group_BoardTypes for makefile \c BOARD constant names): + * - Custom User Boards (with Board Drivers if desired, see \ref Page_WritingBoardDrivers) + */ + +/** + * \page Page_XMEGASupport Atmel USB XMEGA AVR (XMEGA) + * + * \warning The XMEGA device support is currently <b>experimental</b> (incomplete and/or non-functional), and is included for preview purposes only. + * + * \section Sec_XMEGASupport_Devices Supported Microcontroller Models + * + * Currently supported XMEGA models: + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th width="150px">Part</th> + * <th width="150px">USB Device Mode</th> + * <th width="150px">USB Host Mode</th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA16A4U</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA32A4U</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA64A4U</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA128A4U</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA64A3U</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA128A3U</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA192A3U</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA256A3U</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA256A3BU</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA128A1U</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA64B3</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA128B3</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA64B1</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA128B1</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA64C3</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA128C3</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA192C3</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA256C3</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA384C3</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA16C4</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ATXMEGA32C4</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_XMEGASupport_Boards Supported Atmel Boards + * Currently supported Atmel XMEGA boards (see \ref Group_BoardTypes): + * - XMEGA A3BU Xplained + * - XMEGA B1 Xplained + * - XMEGA C3 Xplained + * + * \section Sec_XMEGASupport_ThirdParty Supported Third Party Boards + * Currently supported third-party boards (see \ref Group_BoardTypes for makefile \c BOARD constant names): + * - Custom User Boards (with Board Drivers if desired, see \ref Page_WritingBoardDrivers) + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/DirectorySummaries.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/DirectorySummaries.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..87b863c28b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/DirectorySummaries.txt @@ -0,0 +1,80 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \dir Platform + * \brief Platform specific drivers. + * + * This folder contains platform specific drivers and defines for various supported architectures. These may or may + * not be used in a LUFA application, and are provided for convenience purposes. + * + * \dir Drivers + * \brief Library hardware and software drivers. + * + * This folder contains all the library hardware and software drivers for each supported board, architecture and + * microcontroller model. + * + * \dir Drivers/Misc + * \brief Miscellaneous driver files. + * + * This folder contains drivers for aspects other than the USB interface, board hardware or microcontroller peripherals. + * + * \dir Drivers/Peripheral + * \brief Microcontroller peripheral driver files. + * + * This folder contains drivers for various low level microcontroller peripherals, usually located on the microcontroller + * die within the same physical chip. + * + * \dir Drivers/USB + * \brief USB controller peripheral driver files. + * + * This folder contains the complete LUFA USB stack and controller files, including the core driver and stack, as well + * as the USB class driver implementations. + * + * \dir Drivers/USB/Core + * \brief Core USB driver files. + * + * This folder contains the core USB stack and controller driver files, to correctly implement USB functionality on the + * target architecture and microcontroller model. This + * + * \dir Drivers/USB/Class + * \brief USB Class helper driver files. + * + * This folder contains drivers for implementing functionality of standardized USB classes. These are not used directly by the library, + * but provide a standard and library-maintained way of implementing functionality from some of the defined USB classes without extensive + * development effort. Is is recommended that these drivers be used where possible to reduce maintenance of user applications. + * + * \dir Drivers/USB/Class/Device + * \brief USB Device Class helper driver files. + * + * Device mode drivers for the standard USB classes. + * + * \dir Drivers/USB/Class/Host + * \brief USB Host Class helper driver files. + * + * Host mode drivers for the standard USB classes. + * + * \dir Drivers/Board + * \brief Board hardware driver files. + * + * This folder contains drivers for interfacing with the physical hardware on supported commercial boards, primarily from + * the Atmel corporation. Header files in this folder should be included in user applications requiring the functionality of + * hardware placed on supported boards. + * + * \dir CodeTemplates + * \brief Code templates for use in LUFA powered applications. + * + * This contains code templates for board drivers, sample LUFA project makefiles and other similar templates that can be copied into + * a LUFA powered application and modified to speed up development. + * + * \dir CodeTemplates/DriverStubs + * \brief Driver stub header files for custom boards, to allow the LUFA board drivers to operate. + * + * This contains stub files for the LUFA board drivers. If the LUFA board drivers are used with board hardware other than those + * directly supported by the library, the BOARD parameter of the application's makefile can be set to "USER", and these stub files + * copied to the "/Board/" directory of the application's folder. When fleshed out with working driver code for the custom board, + * the corresponding LUFA board APIs will work correctly with the non-standard board hardware. + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Donating.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Donating.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..68228ac944 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Donating.txt @@ -0,0 +1,25 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** + * \page Page_Donating Donating to Support This Project + * + * \image html Images/Author.jpg "Dean Camera, LUFA Developer" + * + * I am a software developer working on LUFA in my spare time. The development and support of this library requires + * much effort from myself, as I am the sole developer, maintainer and supporter. Please consider donating a small + * amount to support this and my future Open Source projects - All donations are <i>greatly</i> appreciated. + * + * Note that commercial entities can remove the attribution portion of the LUFA license by a one-time fee - see + * \ref Page_LicenseInfo for more details (<b>Note: Please do NOT pay this in advance through the donation link below - + * contact author for payment details.</b>). + * + * \htmlonly + * \image html "http://www.pledgie.com/campaigns/6927.png" + * \endhtmlonly + * <a href="http://www.lufa-lib.org/donate">Donate to this project via PayPal</a> - Thanks in Advance! + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/FutureChanges.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/FutureChanges.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..af11863743 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/FutureChanges.txt @@ -0,0 +1,47 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + + /** \page Page_FutureChanges Future Changes + * + * Below is a list of future changes which are proposed for the LUFA library, but not yet started/complete. + * This gives an unordered list of future changes which may be available in future releases of the library. + * If you have an item to add to this list, please contact the library author via email, the LUFA mailing list, + * or post your suggestion as an enhancement request to the project bug tracker. + * + * <b>Targeted for Future Releases:</b> + * - Code Features + * -# Add hub support when in Host mode for multiple devices + * -# Investigate virtual hubs when in device mode instead of composite devices + * -# Re-add interrupt Pipe/Endpoint support + * -# Update stream APIs to use DMA transfers on supported architectures + * -# Pull out third party libraries into a separate folder and reference them as required + * -# Add a LUFA_YIELD macro for integration into a third-party RTOS + * -# Abstract out Mass Storage byte send/receive to prevent low level API use in projects + * -# Fix HID report parser usage support for array types + * -# Make HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS a global variable that can be changed + * -# Add MANDATORY_EVENT_FUNCTIONS compile time option + * -# Add watchdog support to the library and apps/bootloaders + * -# Limit the maximum size of control transfers + * - Testing/Verification + * -# Re-run USBIF test suite on all classes to formally verify operation + * -# Implement automated functional testing of all demos + * - Documentation/Support + * -# Add detailed overviews of how each demo works + * -# Add board overviews + * -# Write LUFA tutorials + * - Demos/Projects + * -# Add class driver support for Test and Measurement class + * -# Add class driver support for EEM class + * -# Add class driver support for ECM class + * -# Add class driver generic HID report host demo + * -# Implement flow control for USB to Serial project + * - Ports + * -# Port all demos to multiple architectures + * -# Finish USB XMEGA port + * -# Add AVR32 UC3C, UC3D and UC3L support + * -# Other (commercial) C compilers + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/GettingStarted.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/GettingStarted.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9ceec1e04e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/GettingStarted.txt @@ -0,0 +1,37 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \page Page_GettingStarted Getting Started + * + * Getting started with LUFA is easy; read the content below to get on your way to your first LUFA powered application. + * + * \section Sec_DemosOverview The LUFA Demo Applications + * + * Out of the box, LUFA contains a large number of pre-made class demos for you to test, experiment with and + * ultimately build upon for your own projects. All the demos (where possible) come pre-configured to build and + * run correctly on the AT90USB1287 AVR microcontroller, mounted on the Atmel USBKEY board and running at an 8MHz + * master clock. This is due to two reasons; one, it is the hardware the author possesses, and two, it is the most + * popular Atmel USB demonstration board to date. To learn how to reconfigure, recompile and program the included + * LUFA applications using different settings, see the subsections below. + * + * \section Sec_ClassOrLowLevel Class Driver and Low Level Demos + * + * Most of the included demos in the /Demos/ folder come in both ClassDriver and LowLevel varieties. If you are new + * to LUFA, it is highly recommended that you look at the ClassDriver versions first, which use the pre-made USB + * Class Drivers (\ref Group_USBClassDrivers) to simplify the use of the standard USB classes in user applications. + * These demos give a basic but easy to use interface to the USB class used in the demo application, such as HID or + * CDC. + * + * Those needing absolute control over the class implementation can look at the LowLevel demos, which implement the + * required USB class directly in the demo application using the lowest level LUFA APIs. + * + * + * <b>Subsections:</b> + * \li \subpage Page_ConfiguringApps - How to Configure the Included Demos, Projects and Bootloaders + * \li \subpage Page_CompilingApps - How to Compile the Included Demos, Projects and Bootloaders + * \li \subpage Page_ProgrammingApps - How to Program an AVR with the Included Demos, Projects and Bootloaders + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Groups.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Groups.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2dfa4209d4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Groups.txt @@ -0,0 +1,38 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \defgroup Group_BoardDrivers Board Drivers + * + * \brief Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to the control of physical board hardware. + */ + +/** \defgroup Group_PeripheralDrivers On-chip Peripheral Drivers + * + * \brief Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to the control of AVR subsystems. + */ + +/** \defgroup Group_MiscDrivers Miscellaneous Drivers + * + * \brief Miscellaneous driver Functions, macros, variables, enums and types. + */ + +/** \defgroup Group_PlatformDrivers_AVR8 AVR8 + * \ingroup Group_PlatformDrivers + * + * \brief Drivers relating to the AVR8 architecture platform, such as clock setup and interrupt management. + */ + +/** \defgroup Group_PlatformDrivers_XMEGA XMEGA + * \ingroup Group_PlatformDrivers + * + * \brief Drivers relating to the XMEGA architecture platform, such as clock setup and interrupt management. + */ + +/** \defgroup Group_PlatformDrivers_UC3 UC3 + * \ingroup Group_PlatformDrivers + * + * \brief Drivers relating to the UC3 architecture platform, such as clock setup and interrupt management. + */ diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Images/Author.jpg b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Images/Author.jpg Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e8f5541a0e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Images/Author.jpg diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Images/LUFA.png b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Images/LUFA.png Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..54fa1a6643 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Images/LUFA.png diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Images/LUFA_thumb.png b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Images/LUFA_thumb.png Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..efa5386778 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Images/LUFA_thumb.png diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/KnownIssues.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/KnownIssues.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..183036c483 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/KnownIssues.txt @@ -0,0 +1,234 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + + /** \page Page_KnownIssues Known Issues + * The following are known issues present in each official LUFA release. This list should contain all known + * issues in the library. Most of these issues should be corrected in the future release - see + * \ref Page_FutureChanges for a list of planned changes in future releases. + * + * \section Sec_KnownIssues170418 Version 170418 + * - AVR8 Architecture + * - No known issues. + * - UC3 Architecture + * \warning The UC3 device support is currently <b>experimental</b> (incomplete and/or non-functional), and is included for preview purposes only. \n + * + * - No demos, bootloaders or projects have been ported for the UC3 devices in the current release, + * although the architecture is supported in the LUFA core library. + * - DMA transfers to and from the USB controller are not yet implemented for this release. + * - The UC3C, UC3D and UC3L sub-families of UC3 are not currently supported by the library due to their + * altered USB controller design. + * - The various \c *_CreateStream() functions for creating standard \c <stdio.h> compatible virtual file + * streams are not available on the UC3 architecture, due to a lack of suitable library support. + * - XMEGA Architecture + * \warning The XMEGA device support is currently <b>experimental</b> (incomplete and/or non-functional), and is included for preview purposes only. + * + * - Endpoints of more than 64 bytes are not currently supported in this release. + * - Isochronous endpoints are not currently supported in this release. As a result, the audio class + * cannot be used on XMEGA devices. + * - Multiple-bank endpoints are not currently supported in this release. + * - Early silicon revisions of the ATXMEGA128A1U are incompatible with LUFA, due to their various errata + * relating to the USB controller. + * - Architecture Independent + * - The LUFA library is not watchdog aware, and thus timeouts are possible if short periods are used + * and a lengthy USB operation is initiated. + * - No LUFA provided driver INF files for Windows are signed, and thus may fail to install on systems where driver signing is enforced (e.g. Windows 8/10). + * - Build System + * - No known issues. + * - Atmel Studio Integration + * - Not all devices are listed in the "Supported Parts" screen when selecting a device. To select an alternative device, change the "Show Device" drop-down to "All Parts". + * - When switching boards after changing the device selection, a second conflicting \c BOARD symbol definition can be created that prevents successful compilation. To fix, open the project properties window (<i>Project->Project {name} Properties...</i> menu item), click the "Toolchain" tab, click "Symbols" under the "AVR/GNU C Compiler" section and remove the incorrect definition. + * + * \section Sec_KnownIssues151115 Version 151115 + * - AVR8 Architecture + * - No known issues. + * - UC3 Architecture + * \warning The UC3 device support is currently <b>experimental</b> (incomplete and/or non-functional), and is included for preview purposes only. \n + * + * - No demos, bootloaders or projects have been ported for the UC3 devices in the current release, + * although the architecture is supported in the LUFA core library. + * - DMA transfers to and from the USB controller are not yet implemented for this release. + * - The UC3C, UC3D and UC3L sub-families of UC3 are not currently supported by the library due to their + * altered USB controller design. + * - The various \c *_CreateStream() functions for creating standard \c <stdio.h> compatible virtual file + * streams are not available on the UC3 architecture, due to a lack of suitable library support. + * - XMEGA Architecture + * \warning The XMEGA device support is currently <b>experimental</b> (incomplete and/or non-functional), and is included for preview purposes only. + * + * - Endpoints of more than 64 bytes are not currently supported in this release. + * - Isochronous endpoints are not currently supported in this release. As a result, the audio class + * cannot be used on XMEGA devices. + * - Multiple-bank endpoints are not currently supported in this release. + * - Early silicon revisions of the ATXMEGA128A1U are incompatible with LUFA, due to their various errata + * relating to the USB controller. + * - Architecture Independent + * - The LUFA library is not watchdog aware, and thus timeouts are possible if short periods are used + * and a lengthy USB operation is initiated. + * - No LUFA provided driver INF files for Windows are signed, and thus may fail to install on systems where driver signing is enforced (e.g. Windows 8). + * - Build System + * - No known issues. + * - Atmel Studio Integration + * - Not all devices are listed in the "Supported Parts" screen when selecting a device. To select an alternative device, change the "Show Device" drop-down to "All Parts". + * - When switching boards after changing the device selection, a second conflicting \c BOARD symbol definition can be created that prevents successful compilation. To fix, open the project properties window (<i>Project->Project {name} Properties...</i> menu item), click the "Toolchain" tab, click "Symbols" under the "AVR/GNU C Compiler" section and remove the incorrect definition. + * + * \section Sec_KnownIssues140928 Version 140928 + * - AVR8 Architecture + * - No known issues. + * - UC3 Architecture + * \warning The UC3 device support is currently <b>experimental</b> (incomplete and/or non-functional), and is included for preview purposes only. \n + * + * - No demos, bootloaders or projects have been ported for the UC3 devices in the current release, + * although the architecture is supported in the LUFA core library. + * - DMA transfers to and from the USB controller are not yet implemented for this release. + * - The UC3C, UC3D and UC3L sub-families of UC3 are not currently supported by the library due to their + * altered USB controller design. + * - The various \c *_CreateStream() functions for creating standard \c <stdio.h> compatible virtual file + * streams are not available on the UC3 architecture, due to a lack of suitable library support. + * - XMEGA Architecture + * \warning The XMEGA device support is currently <b>experimental</b> (incomplete and/or non-functional), and is included for preview purposes only. + * + * - Endpoints of more than 64 bytes are not currently supported in this release. + * - Isochronous endpoints are not currently supported in this release. As a result, the audio class + * cannot be used on XMEGA devices. + * - Multiple-bank endpoints are not currently supported in this release. + * - Early silicon revisions of the ATXMEGA128A1U are incompatible with LUFA, due to their various errata + * relating to the USB controller. + * - Architecture Independent + * - The LUFA library is not watchdog aware, and thus timeouts are possible if short periods are used + * and a lengthy USB operation is initiated. + * - No LUFA provided driver INF files for Windows are signed, and thus may fail to install on systems where driver signing is enforced (e.g. Windows 8). + * - Build System + * - No known issues. + * - Atmel Studio Integration + * - Not all devices are listed in the "Supported Parts" screen when selecting a device. To select an alternative device, change the "Show Device" drop-down to "All Parts". + * - When switching boards after changing the device selection, a second conflicting \c BOARD symbol definition can be created that prevents successful compilation. To fix, open the project properties window (<i>Project->Project {name} Properties...</i> menu item), click the "Toolchain" tab, click "Symbols" under the "AVR/GNU C Compiler" section and remove the incorrect definition. + * + * \section Sec_KnownIssues140302 Version 140302 + * - AVR8 Architecture + * - No known issues. + * - UC3 Architecture + * \warning The UC3 device support is currently <b>experimental</b> (incomplete and/or non-functional), and is included for preview purposes only. \n + * + * - No demos, bootloaders or projects have been ported for the UC3 devices in the current release, + * although the architecture is supported in the LUFA core library. + * - DMA transfers to and from the USB controller are not yet implemented for this release. + * - The UC3C, UC3D and UC3L sub-families of UC3 are not currently supported by the library due to their + * altered USB controller design. + * - The various \c *_CreateStream() functions for creating standard \c <stdio.h> compatible virtual file + * streams are not available on the UC3 architecture, due to a lack of suitable library support. + * - XMEGA Architecture + * \warning The XMEGA device support is currently <b>experimental</b> (incomplete and/or non-functional), and is included for preview purposes only. + * + * - Endpoints of more than 64 bytes are not currently supported in this release. + * - Isochronous endpoints are not currently supported in this release. As a result, the audio class + * cannot be used on XMEGA devices. + * - Multiple-bank endpoints are not currently supported in this release. + * - Early silicon revisions of the ATXMEGA128A1U are incompatible with LUFA, due to their various errata + * relating to the USB controller. + * - Architecture Independent + * - The LUFA library is not watchdog aware, and thus timeouts are possible if short periods are used + * and a lengthy USB operation is initiated. + * - No LUFA provided driver INF files for Windows are signed, and thus may fail to install on systems where driver signing is enforced (e.g. Windows 8). + * - Build System + * - No known issues. + * - Atmel Studio Integration + * - Not all devices are listed in the "Supported Parts" screen when selecting a device. To select an alternative device, change the "Show Device" drop-down to "All Parts". + * - When switching boards after changing the device selection, a second conflicting BOARD symbol definition can be created that prevents successful compilation. To fix, open the project properties window (<i>Project->Project {name} Properties...</i> menu item), click the Toolchain tab, click "Symbols" under the "AVR/GNU C Compiler" section and remove the incorrect definition. + * + * \section Sec_KnownIssues130901 Version 130901 + * - AVR8 Architecture + * - No known issues. + * - UC3 Architecture + * \warning The UC3 device support is currently <b>experimental</b> (incomplete and/or non-functional), and is included for preview purposes only. \n + * + * - No demos, bootloaders or projects have been ported for the UC3 devices in the current release, + * although the architecture is supported in the LUFA core library. + * - DMA transfers to and from the USB controller are not yet implemented for this release. + * - The UC3C, UC3D and UC3L sub-families of UC3 are not currently supported by the library due to their + * altered USB controller design. + * - The various \c *_CreateStream() functions for creating standard \c <stdio.h> compatible virtual file + * streams are not available on the UC3 architecture, due to a lack of suitable library support. + * - XMEGA Architecture + * \warning The XMEGA device support is currently <b>experimental</b> (incomplete and/or non-functional), and is included for preview purposes only. + * + * - Endpoints of more than 64 bytes are not currently supported in this release. + * - Isochronous endpoints are not currently supported in this release. As a result, the audio class + * cannot be used on XMEGA devices. + * - Multiple-bank endpoints are not currently supported in this release. + * - Early silicon revisions of the ATXMEGA128A1U are incompatible with LUFA, due to their various errata + * relating to the USB controller. + * - Architecture Independent + * - The LUFA library is not watchdog aware, and thus timeouts are possible if short periods are used + * and a lengthy USB operation is initiated. + * - No LUFA provided driver INF files for Windows are signed, and thus may fail to install on systems where driver signing is enforced (e.g. Windows 8). + * - Build System + * - No known issues. + * - Atmel Studio Integration + * - Not all devices are listed in the "Supported Parts" screen when selecting a device. To select an alternative device, change the "Show Device" drop-down to "All Parts". + * - When switching boards after changing the device selection, a second conflicting BOARD symbol definition can be created that prevents successful compilation. To fix, open the project properties window (<i>Project->Project {name} Properties...</i> menu item), click the Toolchain tab, click "Symbols" under the "AVR/GNU C Compiler" section and remove the incorrect definition. + * + * \section Sec_KnownIssues130303 Version 130303 + * - AVR8 Architecture + * - No known issues. + * - UC3 Architecture + * \warning The UC3 device support is currently <b>experimental</b> (incomplete and/or non-functional), and is included for preview purposes only. \n + * + * - No demos, bootloaders or projects have been ported for the UC3 devices in the current release, + * although the architecture is supported in the LUFA core library. + * - DMA transfers to and from the USB controller are not yet implemented for this release. + * - The UC3C, UC3D and UC3L sub-families of UC3 are not currently supported by the library due to their + * altered USB controller design. + * - The various \c CreateStream() functions for creating standard \c <stdio.h> compatible virtual file + * streams are not available on the UC3 architecture, due to a lack of suitable library support. + * - XMEGA Architecture + * \warning The XMEGA device support is currently <b>experimental</b> (incomplete and/or non-functional), and is included for preview purposes only. + * + * - No demos, bootloaders or projects have been ported for the XMEGA devices in the current release, + * although the architecture is supported in the LUFA core library. + * - Endpoints of more than 64 bytes are not currently supported in this release. + * - Isochronous endpoints are not currently supported in this release. As a result, the audio class + * cannot be used on XMEGA devices. + * - Multiple-bank endpoints are not currently supported in this release. + * - Early revisions of the ATXMEGA128A1U are incompatible with LUFA, due to their various errata + * relating to the USB controller. + * - Architecture Independent + * - The LUFA library is not watchdog aware, and thus timeouts are possible if short periods are used + * and a lengthy USB operation is initiated. + * - No LUFA provided driver INF files for Windows are signed, and thus may fail to install on systems where driver signing is enforced (e.g. Windows 8). + * - Build System + * - No known issues. + * + * \section Sec_KnownIssues120730 Version 120730 + * - AVR8 Architecture + * - No known issues. + * - UC3 Architecture + * \warning The UC3 device support is currently <b>experimental</b> (incomplete and/or non-functional), and is included for preview purposes only. \n + * + * - No demos, bootloaders or projects have been ported for the UC3 devices in the current release, + * although the architecture is supported in the LUFA core library. + * - DMA transfers to and from the USB controller are not yet implemented for this release. + * - The UC3C, UC3D and UC3L sub-families of UC3 are not currently supported by the library due to their + * altered USB controller design. + * - The various \c CreateStream() functions for creating standard \c <stdio.h> compatible virtual file + * streams are not available on the UC3 architecture, due to a lack of suitable library support. + * - XMEGA Architecture + * \warning The XMEGA device support is currently <b>experimental</b> (incomplete and/or non-functional), and is included for preview purposes only. + * + * - No demos, bootloaders or projects have been ported for the XMEGA devices in the current release, + * although the architecture is supported in the LUFA core library. + * - Endpoints of more than 64 bytes are not currently supported in this release. + * - Isochronous endpoints are not currently supported in this release. As a result, the audio class + * cannot be used on XMEGA devices. + * - Multiple-bank endpoints are not currently supported in this release. + * - Early revisions of the ATXMEGA128A1U are incompatible with LUFA, due to their various errata + * relating to the USB controller. + * - Architecture Independent + * - The LUFA library is not watchdog aware, and thus timeouts are possible if short periods are used + * and a lengthy USB operation is initiated. + * - No LUFA provided driver INF files for Windows are signed, and thus may fail to install on systems where driver signing is enforced (e.g. Windows 8). + * - Build System + * - No known issues. + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/LUFAPoweredProjects.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/LUFAPoweredProjects.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fa94add496 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/LUFAPoweredProjects.txt @@ -0,0 +1,226 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \page Page_LUFAPoweredProjects User Projects Powered by LUFA + * + * LUFA is currently in use all around the world, in many applications both commercial and non-commercial. Below is a + * list of known public LUFA powered projects, which all use the LUFA library in some way. Feel free to visit each project's + * home page for more information on each project. + * + * If you have a project that you would like to add to this list, please contact me via the details on the main page of this + * documentation. + * + * \section Sec_BoardsUsingLUFA AVR-USB Development Boards Using LUFA + * + * The following is a list of known AVR USB development boards, which recommend using LUFA for the USB stack. Some of these + * are open design, and all are available for purchase as completed development boards suitable for project development. + * + * \li AVR-USB-162, a USBKEY-like development board for the AT90USB162: http://olimex.com/dev/avr-usb-162.html + * \li Benito #7, a no-frills USB board: http://www.dorkbotpdx.org/wiki/benito + * \li Duce, the successor to the Benito #7: http://dorkbotpdx.org/wiki/duce + * \li JM-DB-U2, an ATMEGA32U2 development board: http://u2.mattair.net/index.html + * \li Micropendous, an open design/source set of AVR USB development boards: http://micropendous.org/ + * \li Microsin AVR-USB162 breakout board, a DIY AT90USB162 development board: http://microsin.ru/content/view/685/44/ + * \li Minimus USB, a board specially designed for PSGroove: http://www.minimususb.com/ + * \li Nanduino, a do-it-yourself AT90USB162 board: http://www.makestuff.eu/wordpress/?page_id=569 + * \li Sparkfun ATMEGA8U2 breakout board: http://www.sparkfun.com/products/10277 + * \li Teensy and Teensy++, two other AVR USB development boards: http://www.pjrc.com/teensy/index.html + * \li U2DIL/U4DIL, a set of DIP layout USB AVR boards: http://www.reworld.eu/re/en/products/u2dil/ + * \li USB2AX, a tiny USB to serial converter board: http://paranoidstudio.assembla.com/wiki/show/paranoidstudio/USB2AX + * \li USBFOO 2, AT90USB162 based development board: http://shop.kernelconcepts.de/product_info.php?products_id=102 + * + * \section Sec_LUFAProjects Projects Using LUFA (Hobbyist) + * + * The following are known hobbyist projects using LUFA. Most are open source, and show off interesting ways that the LUFA library + * can be incorporated into many different applications. + * + * \li Accelerometer Game Joystick: http://www.crictor.co.il/he/episodes/joystick/ + * \li Adjacent Reality Motion Tracker: http://www.adjacentreality.org/ + * \li AD9833 based USB Function Generator: http://tuomasnylund.fi/drupal6/content/ad9833-based-usb-function-generator + * \li AERY development platform for the AVR32 devices: http://www.aery32.com/ + * \li AM Radio transmitter: http://amcinnes.info/2012/uc_am_xmit/ + * \li Arcade Controller: http://fletchtronics.net/arcade-controller-made-petunia + * \li Arcade Joystick: http://jamie.lentin.co.uk/embedded/arcade-joystick/ + * \li AttoBasic AVR BASIC interpreter: http://cappels.org/dproj/AttoBasic_Home/AttoBasic_Home.html + * \li AVR USB Modem, a 3G Wireless Modem host: http://code.google.com/p/avrusbmodem/ + * \li Bicycle POV: http://www.code.google.com/p/bicycleledpov/ + * \li Bluetooth Explorerbot: http://code.google.com/p/bluetooth-explorerbot/ + * \li Bus Ninja, an AVR clone of the popular BusPirate project: http://blog.hodgepig.org/busninja/ + * \li CAMTRIG, a remote Camera Trigger device: http://code.astraw.com/projects/motmot/camtrig + * \li ChameleonMini, a smart card emulator: https://github.com/skuep/ChameleonMini + * \li CD Driver Emulator Dongle for ISO Files: http://cdemu.blogspot.com/ + * \li ChipWhisperer, a signal capture device: https://www.assembla.com/spaces/chipwhisperer/wiki/ChipWhisperer_Rev2_Capture_Hardware + * \li ClockTamer, a configurable clock generator: http://code.google.com/p/clock-tamer/ + * \li Collection of alternative Arduino Uno firmwares: http://hunt.net.nz/users/darran/ + * \li Computer controlled LED matrix (Russian): http://we.easyelectronics.ru/AVR/nebolshoy-primer-s-lufa-hidapi.html + * \li CULFW, a 868MHz RF packet encoder/decoder: http://www.koeniglich.de/culfw/culfw.html + * \li Dashkey, a custom PC keyboard controller: http://geekhack.org/showwiki.php?title=Island:19096 + * \li DIY PS3 controller emulator: https://code.google.com/p/diyps3controller/ + * \li EMuSer, a USB-RS422 adapter for E-Mu samplers: http://www.emxp.net/EMuSer.htm + * \li EQ Track, a telescope mount controller: http://sourceforge.net/projects/eqtrack/ + * \li Estick JTAG, an ARM JTAG debugger: http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/ + * \li "Fingerlicking Wingdinger" (WARNING: Bad language if no Javascript), a MIDI controller: http://noisybox.net/electronics/wingdinger/ + * \li Flyatar, a real-time fly tracking system: https://github.com/peterpolidoro/Flyatar + * \li FootJoy, a 22 button, 6-axis josystick with keyboard and mouse modes: https://bitbucket.org/sirbrialliance/foot-joy/ + * \li Gamecube controller to USB adapter: https://www.facebook.com/media/set/?set=a.10150202447076304.310536.688776303&l=df53851c50 + * \li Garmin GPS USB to NMEA standard serial sentence translator: http://github.com/nall/garmin-transmogrifier/tree/master + * \li Geiger Counter with USB interface: http://www.hforsten.com/i-made-a-geiger-counter.html + * \li Generic HID Device Creator: http://generichid.sourceforge.net/ + * \li Generic HID Open Source Framework: http://www.waitingforfriday.com/index.php/USB_Generic_HID_Open_Source_Framework_for_Atmel_AVR_and_Windows + * \li Ghetto Drum, a MIDI drum controller: http://noisybox.net/art/gdrum/ + * \li GPS enabled lap timer for vehicles: http://www.assembla.com/code/ironlung/subversion/nodes/trunk/LapTimer + * \li GSynth, an 8-bit sound synthesizer: https://github.com/gcielniak/GSynth + * \li Gumbi, a Python library and USB GPIO controller: https://code.google.com/p/gumbi/ + * \li Hardware Volume Control: https://github.com/davidk/hw-volume-control + * \li Hiduino, a USB-MIDI replacement firmware for the Arduino Uno: http://code.google.com/p/hiduino/ + * \li HoodLoader2, an Arduino Uno enhanced USB AVR coprocessor firmware: https://github.com/NicoHood/HoodLoader2 + * \li IBM capacitive keybord replacement controller: http://downloads.cornall.co/ibm-capsense-usb-web/ibm-capsense-usb.html + * \li Ikea RGB LED USB modification: http://slashhome.se/p/projects/id/ikea_dioder_usb/#project + * \li IR electricity meter monitor: http://sourceforge.net/projects/irmetermon/ + * \li IR Remote to Keyboard decoder: http://netzhansa.blogspot.com/2010/04/our-living-room-hi-fi-setup-needs-mp3.html + * \li Jukebox panic button: http://thinkl33t.co.uk/the-panic-button + * \li Kinesis replacement firmware: https://github.com/chrisandreae/kinesis-firmware + * \li LED Panel controller: http://projects.peterpolidoro.net/caltech/panelscontroller/panelscontroller.htm + * \li Linux Secure Storage Dongle: http://github.com/TomMD/teensy + * \li LUFA powered DDR dance mat (French): http://logicien-parfait.fr/dokuwiki/doku.php?id=projet:ddr_repair + * \li Macintosh SIMM ROM Programmer: https://code.google.com/p/mac-rom-simm-programmer/ + * \li MakeTV Episode Dispenser: http://www.youtube.com/watch?v=BkWUi18hl3g + * \li Mec64,a Commodore 64 keyboard: http://deskthority.net/workshop-f7/mec64-keyboard-t4522.html + * \li MidiMonster, a USB-to-MIDI gateway board: http://www.dorkbotpdx.org/wiki/midimonster + * \li MIDI Theremin: http://baldwisdom.com/usb-midi-controller-theremin-style-on-arduino-uno/ + * \li MIDI interface hack of a toy Guitar: http://blog.x37v.info/2011/06/26/toy-guitar-hacked-midi-conroller + * \li MiniBloq, a graphical Ardunio programming environment : http://minibloq.org/ + * \li MiXley, a port of the Teacup 3D printer firmware for the USB AVRs: http://codaset.com/michielh/mixley + * \li Mobo 4.3, a USB controlled all band (160-10m) HF SDR transceiver: http://sites.google.com/site/lofturj/mobo4_3 + * \li Moco, a native Arduino Uno MIDI replacement firmware: http://web.mac.com/kuwatay/morecat_lab./MocoLUFA.html + * \li Monash ECSE Smart Packet Radio Testbed: http://www.ecse.monash.edu.au/twiki/bin/view/WSRNLab/SmartPacketRadio + * \li Motherboard BIOS flasher: http://www.coreboot.org/InSystemFlasher + * \li Multi-button Joystick (French): http://logicien-parfait.fr/dokuwiki/doku.php?id=projet:joystick + * \li Music Playing Alarm Clock (Tutorial): http://www.instructables.com/id/Music-Playing-Alarm-Clock/ + * \li Nehebkau, Laptop Controlled Keyboard and Mouse: http://www.frank-zhao.com/cache/nehebkau.php + * \li NeroJTAG, a JTAG dongle: https://github.com/makestuff/neroJtag + * \li NES Controller USB modification: https://github.com/nfd/nes_adapter + * \li Nikon wireless camera remote control (Norwegian): http://hekta.org/~hpe1119/ + * \li Nintendo Four-Score, USB NES 4-player controller adapter: http://www.waitingforfriday.com/index.php/Nintendo_Four_Score_USB + * \li Numpad keyboard: http://tuomasnylund.fi/drupal6/content/usb-cherry-mx-numpad + * \li Opendous-JTAG, an open source ARM JTAG debugger: http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/ + * \li Openkubus, an open source hardware-based authentication dongle: http://code.google.com/p/openkubus/ + * \li Orbee, a USB connected RGB Orb for notifications: http://www.franksworkshop.com.au/Electronics/Orbee/Orbee.htm + * \li Password keyring: http://owlsan.blogspot.no/2014/06/keyring-project-version-10.html + * \li Picade alternative firmware, a retro Arcade controller/cabinet: https://github.com/rktrlng/picade_lufa + * \li PPM signal generator over USB: https://github.com/G33KatWork/USBPPM + * \li Programmable keyboard controller: http://41j.com/blog/2011/10/a-programmable-keyboard-controller/ + * \li Programmable XBOX controller: http://richard-burke.dyndns.org/wordpress/pan-galactic-gargantuan-gargle-brain-aka-xbox-360-usb-controller/ + * \li Project Surface, a touch interface controller for Windows 8: https://code.google.com/p/project-surface/ + * \li PSGroove, a Playstation 3 Homebrew dongle: http://github.com/psgroove + * \li PS/2 to USB adapter: https://github.com/makestuff/p2ukbd + * \li RaspiFace, an Arduino platform bridge for the Raspberry Pi: http://www.raspiface.com/ + * \li Reflow oven controller: http://danstrother.com/2011/01/15/reflow-oven-controller/ + * \li RFPirate, a RF experimentation platform: https://github.com/ebuller/RF-Pirate + * \li RF Power Meter, based on the AD8307 log amp: https://sites.google.com/site/lofturj/ad8307-power-meter + * \li RF Transceiver using the MRF49XA: http://alternet.us.com/?page_id=1494 + * \li SD Card reader: http://elasticsheep.com/2010/04/teensy2-usb-mass-storage-with-an-sd-card/ + * \li SDR1, a Software Defined Radio firmware: https://code.google.com/p/sdr-mk1/ + * \li SEGA Megadrive/Genesis Development Cartridge: http://www.makestuff.eu/wordpress/?page_id=398 + * \li Serial Line bus analyser: http://www.pjrc.com/teensy/projects/SerialAnalyzer.html + * \li Simple USB LED Controller (SULC): https://github.com/scottbez1/sulc + * \li SNES custom FLASH ROM: http://electrifiedfoolingmachine.co/?page_id=633 + * \li Smartcard Detective: https://code.google.com/p/smartcarddetective/ + * \li SmartportVHD Apple II Mass Storage adapter: http://pcedric3.free.fr/SmartportVHD/ + * \li Single LED Matrix Display: http://guysoft.wordpress.com/2009/10/08/bumble-b/ + * \li Simple USB LED Controller: https://github.com/scottbez1/sulc + * \li Stripe Snoop, a Magnetic Card reader: http://www.ossguy.com/ss_usb/ + * \li Stylophone, with USB MIDI connectivity: http://www.waitingforfriday.com/index.php/Stylophone_Studio_5 + * \li Teensy SD Card .WAV file player: http://elasticsheep.com/2010/04/teensy2-usb-wav-player-part-1/ + * \li Touch It (Fabulously), presumably art: http://touch.it.fa.bulo.us/ly/ + * \li Touchscreen Input Device: http://capnstech.blogspot.com/2010/07/touchscreen-update.html + * \li UDFS, a BBC Micro USB disk filing system: https://github.com/makestuff/udfs + * \li Universal USB AVR Module: http://usbavr.bplaced.net/ + * \li USB2AX, a USB to Dynamixel network adapter: http://paranoidstudio.assembla.com/wiki/show/paranoidstudio/USB2AX + * \li USBPass, a USB password keeper: http://sroz.net/projects/usbpass/ + * \li USB Business Card: http://www.limpkin.fr/index.php?post/2012/09/15/My-new-business-card + * \li USB Function Generator: http://tuomasnylund.fi/drupal6/content/ad9833-based-usb-function-generator + * \li USB Infrared Receiver/Transmitter: http://vaton4.web2001.cz/ + * \li USB Interface for Playstation Portable Devices: http://forums.ps2dev.org/viewtopic.php?t=11001 + * \li USB MIDI to DMX controller: http://github.com/hanshuebner/miDiMX + * \li USB Mood Light: https://github.com/hsbp/usb_moodlight + * \li USB powered Geiger Counter: http://uhrheber.wordpress.com/2011/04/28/a-usb-powered-geiger-counter-for-the-z2-and-other-computers/ + * \li Userial, a USB to Serial converter with SPI, I2C and other protocols: http://www.tty1.net/userial/ + * \li Wii Classic Controller to USB converter: https://github.com/crazyiop/wii-classic-2-usb + * \li Wireless MIDI Guitar system: http://www.ise.pw.edu.pl/~wzab/wireless_guitar_system/ + * \li XBOX 360 Startup Sound Changer: http://www.homebrew-connection.org/change-your-xbox-360-startup-sounds-yourself/ + * \li Xnormidi, a C MIDI library: http://x37v.info/projects/xnormidi + * \li XUM1541, a Commodore 64 floppy drive to USB adapter: http://www.root.org/~nate/c64/xum1541/ + * \li Zeus, a touch screen computer for music manipulation: http://www.benbengler.com/developments_zeus.html + * + * \section Sec_LUFACommercialProjects Projects Using LUFA (Commercial) + * + * The following is a list of known commercial products using LUFA. Some of these are open source, although many are "black-box" + * solutions with no source code given. Those companies which have purchased a Commercial License to LUFA (see \ref Page_LicenseInfo) + * are not listed here unless specifically requested. + * + * \li Alphasphere, a MIDI input sphere device for music creation: http://www.alphasphere.com/ + * \li Arduino Uno and Leonardo, official Arduino boards: http://www.arduino.cc + * \li ARPS Locator: http://la3t.hamradio.no/lab//?id=tracker_en + * \li AsTeRICS assistive technologies project, HID actuator: http://www.asterics.eu + * \li BitFury, a Bitcoin ASIC miner: https://github.com/aauer1/LUFA-BitFury/tree/master/Projects/BitfuryBTC + * \li Ceberus, a MadCatz Xbox 360 arcade stick modifier: http://www.phreakmods.com/products/cerberus + * \li CFFA3000, a CompactFlash interface for the Apple II: http://www.dreher.net/CFforAppleII + * \li ChameleonMini, a RFID monitoring tool: https://github.com/emsec/ChameleonMini/wiki + * \li Digital Survey Instruments Magnetometer and Pointer: http://www.digitalsurveyinstruments.com/ + * \li FinchRobot, a robot designed for educational use: http://www.finchrobot.com/ + * \li Flysight, a GPS logger for wingsuit pilots: http://flysight.ca/ + * \li Goldilocks, an Arduino compatible clone: http://feilipu.me/2014/03/08/goldilocks-1284p-arduino-uno-clone/ + * \li HummingBird Kit, a robotics learning platform: http://www.hummingbirdkit.com/ + * \li LP1, an AVRISP-MKII Clone AVR Programmer: http://embeddedglow.com/items/LP1/LP1.php + * \li Penguino, an Arduino Board With On-Board LUFA Powered Debugger/Programmer: http://wiki.icy.com.au/PenguinoAVR + * \li PhatIO, a filesystem based I/O interface: http://www.phatio.com/ + * \li PIR-1, an IR control interface for consumer electronics: http://www.promixis.com/pir-1.php + * \li PIR-4, a USB Connected 4 port IR transmitter: http://promixis.com/pir-4.php + * \li PortPilot, a USB device charger with power meter: http://portpilot.net/ + * \li KeyGlove, an alternative input system: http://www.keyglove.net/ + * \li Many of Busware's Products: http://www.busware.de/ + * \li MIDIFighter, a USB-MIDI controller: http://www.midifighter.com/ + * \li MIDI USB Arduino Shield: http://openpipe.cc/products/midi-usb-shield/ + * \li Norduino, a wireless Arduino: http://norduino.robomotic.com/norduino-is-now-usb-hid/ + * \li Olimex AVR-ISP-MK2, an AVRISP-MKII Clone AVR Programmer: https://www.olimex.com/dev/avr-isp-mk2.html + * \li Retrode, a USB Games Console Cartridge Reader: http://www.retrode.org + * \li RFI21.1EU UHF RFID reader: http://www.metra.cz/rfid/uhf-rfid-ctecky/rfi21-1eu-uhf-rfid-ctecka.htm + * \li SmartCardDetective, a Smart Card analysis tool: http://www.smartcarddetective.com/ + * \li TimelapsePlus, a digital camera time lapse tool: https://github.com/timelapseplus/TimelapsePlus-Firmware + * \li USBTINY-MKII, an AVRISP-MKII Clone AVR Programmer: http://tom-itx.no-ip.biz:81/~webpage/boards/USBTiny_Mkii/USBTiny_Mkii_index.php + * \li UDS18B20 USB Temperature sensor: http://toughlog.org/uds18b20/ + * \li VMeter, a USB MIDI touch strip controller: http://www.vmeter.net/ + * \li XMEGA Development Board, using LUFA as an On-Board Programmer: http://xmega.mattair.net/ + * \li Zeptoprog, a multifunction AVR programmer: http://www.mattairtech.com/index.php/featured/zeptoprog.html + * + * \section Sec_LUFAPublications Publications Mentioning LUFA + * The following are published magazines which have either mentioned or featured the LUFA library. + * + * \li Elektor Magazine, "My First AVR-USB" by Antoine Authier (feature), January 2010 Issue + * \li Elektor Magazine, "USB is Cool/Sucks" by Jerry Jacobs and Chris Vossen (minor mention), January 2010 Issue + * \li Elektor Magazine, "20 x Open Source" by Jens Nickel, March 2010 Issue + * \li Circuit Cellar Magazine, "Advanced USB Design Debugging" by Collin O'Flynn, August 2010 Issue + * \li "Some Assembly Required: Assembly Language Programming with the AVR Microcontroller" by Timothy S. Margush + * \li Elektor Magazine, "Taming the Beast (2)" by Clemens Valens/Raymond Vermeulen, January 2014 Issue + * + * \section Sec_LUFANotableMentions Other Notable Mentions of LUFA + * The following are non-print but notable mentions of the LUFA library. + * + * \li Adafruit "Ask an Engineer", 7th November 2010 + * \li Arduino 2010 Keynote speech + * \li The Amp Hour podcast blog #11 + * \li Blackhat 2011 conference, "Exploiting USB Devices with Arduino" + * + * \section Sec_PortsAndForks Non-Official LUFA Ports and Forks + * The following are unofficial forks of the LUFA codebase, which implement different features such as support for + * additional architectures. + * + * \li NXP's official LPCOpen "LPCUSBLib" LUFA fork, for LPC devices: http://www.lpcware.com/ + * \li Kevin Mehall's LUFA port to the NXP LPC13xx: https://github.com/kevinmehall/LUFA-LPC13xx + * \li Mark Ding's port for the Silicon Labs SiM3U1xx: https://www.github.com/MarkDing/USB_CDC + * \li Mark Ding's port for the Silicon Labs EFM32 Giant Gecko: https://github.com/MarkDing/lufa-efm32 + */ diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/LibraryResources.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/LibraryResources.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f69d4344c1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/LibraryResources.txt @@ -0,0 +1,33 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** + * \page Page_Resources Library Resources + * + * \section Sec_UnofficialResources Unofficial Resources + * Unofficial Russian LUFA documentation translation: http://microsin.ru/Download.cnt/doc/LUFA/ \n + * Tutorial for LUFA USB Control Transfers: http://www.avrbeginners.net/new/tutorials/usb-control-transfers-with-lufa/ + * + * \section Sec_ProjectPages LUFA Related Webpages + * Project Homepage: http://www.lufa-lib.org \n + * Commercial Licenses: http://www.lufa-lib.org/license \n + * Author's Website: http://www.fourwalledcubicle.com \n + * Development Blog: http://www.fourwalledcubicle.com/blog \n + * + * \section Sec_ProjectHelp Assistance With LUFA + * Support Mailing List: http://www.lufa-lib.org/support \n + * Author's Email: dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com \n + * + * \section Sec_InDevelopment Latest In-Development Source Code + * Issue Tracker: http://www.lufa-lib.org/tracker \n + * Public GIT Repository: http://www.lufa-lib.org/git \n + * Latest Repository Source Archive: http://www.lufa-lib.org/latest-archive \n + * Commit RSS Feed: http://www.lufa-lib.org/rss \n + * + * \section Sec_USBResources USB Resources + * USB-IF Website: http://www.usb.org \n + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/LicenseInfo.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/LicenseInfo.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..86ed124bb2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/LicenseInfo.txt @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** + * \page Page_LicenseInfo Source Code License + * + * The LUFA library is currently released under the MIT license, included below. + * + * \section Sec_LicenseForHumans License Summary for Human Beings + * Everyone is free to use LUFA without payment - even in commercial applications + * where the product source code is not publicly disclosed. However, use of the + * library must be in accordance with the library license conditions. + * + * If you wish to use LUFA without payment, you <b>must</b> include a copy of the + * full license text below with your product or project - on your website, and in + * an accompanying manual or other materials for the product. As long as the entire + * license text is made available and obvious to the users of your product, you + * are free to incorporate the LUFA library into your product without special + * additional licensing. + * + * \section Sec_CommercialLicenses Commercial Licensing + * In some instances the small requirement for public disclosure of LUFA within a + * product is unwanted; in these instances a commercial license is offered up as an + * alternative to the standard LUFA license. + * + * Commercial entities can opt out of the public disclosure clause in this license + * for a one-time US$1500 payment. This provides a non-exclusive modified MIT + * licensed which allows for the free use of the LUFA library, bootloaders and + * (where the sole copyright is attributed to Dean Camera) demos without public + * disclosure within an organization, in addition to three free hours of consultation + * with the library author, and priority support. + * + * Please visit the Commercial License link on \ref Page_Resources for more information on + * ordering a commercial license for your company. + * + * \section Sec_LicenseText LUFA License Text + * + * \verbinclude License.txt + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/MainPage.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/MainPage.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e737c39b5a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/MainPage.txt @@ -0,0 +1,52 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** + * \mainpage + * + * \image html Images/LUFA.png + * <div align="center"><small><i>Logo design by <a href="http://www.studiomonsoon.com">Studio Monsoon Photography</a></i></small></div> + * \n + * <div align="center"><a href="http://www.lufa-lib.org">http://www.lufa-lib.org</a></div> + * \n + * + * <b>LUFA is donationware. For author and donation information, see \ref Page_Donating.</b> + * + * LUFA is an open-source USB library for the USB-enabled AVR microcontrollers, released under the MIT license (see \ref Page_LicenseInfo). + * It supports a large number of USB AVR models and boards (see \ref Page_DeviceSupport). It is designed to provide an easy to use, + * feature rich framework for the development of USB peripherals and hosts. + * + * LUFA focuses on the microcontroller side of USB development only; it includes no PC host USB driver development facilities - other projects + * such as the Windows Driver Development Kit, Windows USB Device Mode Framework and libusb may be of interest for developing custom OS drivers. + * While custom USB devices can be made with LUFA using such tools, the included demos all use the inbuilt OS drivers for each USB class for + * simplicity. + * + * The library is currently in a stable release, suitable for download and incorporation into user projects for + * both host and device modes. For information about the project progression, see the blog link at \ref Page_Resources. + * + * LUFA is written specifically for the free AVR-GCC compiler, and uses several GCC-only extensions to make the + * library API more streamlined and robust. You can download AVR-GCC for free in a convenient windows package, + * from the the WinAVR website (see \ref Page_Resources). + * + * The only required AVR peripherals for LUFA is the USB controller itself and interrupts - LUFA does not require the use of the + * microcontroller's timers or other hardware, leaving more hardware to the application developer. + * + * Accompanying LUFA in the download package is a set of example demo applications, plus several Bootloaders of different classes + * and open source LUFA powered projects. + * + * <b>Subsections:</b> + * \li \subpage Page_LicenseInfo - Project source license and commercial use information + * \li \subpage Page_Donating - Donating to support this project + * \li \subpage Page_DeviceSupport - Current Device and Hardware Support + * \li \subpage Page_ChangeLog - Project Changelog + * \li \subpage Page_KnownIssues - Known Issues + * \li \subpage Page_FutureChanges - Planned Changes to the Library + * \li \subpage Page_GettingStarted - Getting started with LUFA + * \li \subpage Page_DevelopingWithLUFA - Developing with LUFA + * \li \subpage Page_LUFAPoweredProjects - Other Projects Using LUFA + * \li \subpage Page_Resources - LUFA and USB Related Resources + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/MigrationInformation.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/MigrationInformation.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7efb312ea8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/MigrationInformation.txt @@ -0,0 +1,717 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \page Page_Migration Migrating from Older Versions + * + * Below is migration information for updating existing projects based on previous versions of the LUFA library + * to the next version released. It does not indicate all new additions to the library in each version change, only + * areas relevant to making older projects compatible with the API changes of each new release. + * + * \section Sec_Migration170418 Version 170418 + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - The \c CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor() callback function into the user application's \c wIndex parameter is now \c uint16_t, not \c uint8_t. + * + * \section Sec_Migration151115 Migrating from 140928 to 151115 + * <b>Non-USB Library Components</b> + * - The ATPROGRAM LUFA build system module now defaults to the Atmel ICE debugger tool, instead of the Atmel JTAG ICE3. + * - The \c Serial_CreateStream() and \c Serial_CreateBlockingStream() functions now require a USART base pointer for XMEGA devices as the first parameter. + * + * \section Sec_Migration140928 Migrating from 140302 to 140928 + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - The device mode RNDIS class driver now requires a user-supplied buffer and buffer length to operate, rather + * than allocating this buffer internally. + * + * \section Sec_Migration140302 Migrating from 130901 to 140302 + * <b>USB Core</b> + * - The \c VERSION_BCD() macro has changed from accepting one floating point parameter to taking three distinct major/minor/revision integer parameters, as + * some edge cases caused incorrect parsing of the input float into the final integer BCD encoded value. + * + * <b>Non-USB Library Components</b> + * - The \c ATTR_NEVER_INLINE macro, erroneously introduced in a previous release has been removed, as it duplicates the existing \c ATTR_NO_INLINE macro. + * + * <b>Build System</b> + * - The default configuration file for Doxygen is now "doxyfile" rather than "Doxygen.conf", to conform to the Doxygen project's own default file name. + * Set \c DOXYGEN_CONF to override the new default file name. + * + * \section Sec_Migration130901 Migrating from 130303 to 130901 + * <b>Non-USB Library Components</b> + * - The Board Dataflash \c Dataflash_Init() function now automatically configures the appropriate communication interface. + * + * \section Sec_Migration130303 Migrating from 120730 to 130303 + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - The \ref HID_KEYBOARD_LED_KANA macro was previously misspelled as \c HID_KEYBOARD_LED_KATANA, and had an incorrect value. User applications requiring this + * constant should use the new name, and remove any workarounds for the previously incorrect macro definition. + * - The \c HID_KEYBOARD_SC_EQUAL_SIGN macro has been renamed to \ref HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_EQUAL_SIGN, and the previous definition of + * \c HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_EQUAL_SIGN has been renamed \ref HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_EQUAL_SIGN_AS400 to conform to the definitions in the HID specification. + * + * <b>Host Mode</b> + * - The \ref HID_KEYBOARD_LED_KANA macro was previously misspelled as \c HID_KEYBOARD_LED_KATANA, and had an incorrect value. User applications requiring this + * constant should use the new name, and remove any workarounds for the previously incorrect macro definition. + * - The \c HID_KEYBOARD_SC_EQUAL_SIGN macro has been renamed to \ref HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_EQUAL_SIGN, and the previous definition of + * \c HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_EQUAL_SIGN has been renamed \ref HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_EQUAL_SIGN_AS400 to conform to the definitions in the HID specification. + * + * \section Sec_Migration120730 Migrating from 120219 to 120730 + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - The device mode Audio Class driver now requires an additional configuration parameter, the Audio Control interface index. Existing applications should + * be adjusted to specify the additional configuration parameter. + * - The HID_DESCRIPTOR_JOYSTICK() macro no longer takes a variable number of axis as a parameter, due to OS incompatibilities; this macro now uses a fixed + * 3 axis of data. User applications should update their calls to this macro and their report structures to suit a fixed 3-axis joystick report. If a user + * application requires more than 3 axis' of data, a custom report descriptor will need to be constructed by hand. + * - The \ref Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint() function no longer takes in masks for the banks and direction; the number of banks is now an integer argument, and + * the direction is obtained from the full endpoint address within the device. Applications calling Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint() should update their API + * call to use a full endpoint address (including ENDPOINT_DIR_IN or ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT direction in the MSB of the endpoint address) and an integer number + * of banks. + * - All endpoint functions now operate on full endpoint addresses within the device, rather than a directionless endpoint index. Applications should update + * their API calls to use full endpoint addresses when required within the device. + * - All device mode class drivers have been updated to use a new unified endpoint description structure for all endpoints; existing applications will need + * to update their class driver struct instantiation to match the new scheme (see \ref USB_Endpoint_Table_t). + * - The \c ENDPOINT_BANKS_SUPPORTED() and \c ENDPOINT_MAX_ENDPOINT_SIZE() macros have been removed, as these do not function correctly with the new addressing + * scheme for the endpoint APIs. Please refer to the target device's datasheet for the maximum bank size of each endpoint. + * - The MIDI class driver \ref MIDI_EventPacket_t event packet no longer contains separate \c CableIndex and \c Command entries; these have been combined + * into a single \c Event element which can be constructed using the new macro \ref MIDI_EVENT(). Existing applications should use the new macro and structure + * element name. + * + * <b>Host Mode</b> + * - The Android Accessory Host class driver property strings are now a array of \c char* rather than a struct of named pointers. Existing applications + * should use C99 Designated Initializers with the property string indexes located in \ref AOA_Strings_t instead. + * - The \ref Pipe_ConfigurePipe() function no longer takes in masks for the banks and token; the number of banks is now an integer argument, and the token + * is now inferred from the full pipe address within the device, and the pipe type. Applications calling Pipe_ConfigurePipe() should update their API + * call to use a full pipe address (including PIPE_DIR_IN or PIPE_DIR_OUT direction in the MSB of the pipe address) and an integer number of banks. + * - All pipe functions now operate on full pipe addresses within the device, rather than a directionless pipe index. Applications should update their API + * calls to use full pipe addresses when required within the device. + * - All host mode class drivers have been updated to use a new unified pipe description structure for all pipes; existing applications will need to update + * their class driver struct instantiation to match the new scheme (see \ref USB_Pipe_Table_t). + * - The MIDI class driver \ref MIDI_EventPacket_t event packet no longer contains seperate \c CableIndex and \c Command entries; these have been combined + * into a single \c Event element which can be constructed using the new macro \ref MIDI_EVENT(). Existing applications should use the new macro and structure + * element name. + * - The library "LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/ConfigDescriptor.c" source file has been renamed "LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/ConfigDescriptors.c" as this was clashing with + * files in some low level host mode demo applications, preventing parallel project builds. If you are referencing the project source files directly instead + * of using the makefile module names, you will need to adjust your project makefile. + * + * \section Sec_Migration120219 Migrating from 111009 to 120219 + * <b>USB Core</b> + * - The HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFER_* macros in the HID class driver have been corrected to HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFIER_* (note the spelling of "modifier"). + * Existing applications should switch over to the correctly spelled macro names. + * - The names of the USB Device and USB Host class driver files have changed; a new "ClassDevice" and "ClassHost" postfix has been added to the + * respective class driver files. Projects referencing the class driver source files by filename rather than the LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS makefile + * variable should append these postfixes to the source file names. Projects including the USB class driver dispatch headers directly should either + * switch to including the main USB driver header instead, or use the updated header filenames. + * - The USB_CONFIG_ATTR_BUSPOWERED constant has been renamed to USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED, as this was misnamed. All devices must set this bit in + * the Configuration descriptor's attributes field. As all devices are assumed to be bus-powered unless stated otherwise with the + * USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED flag a replacement constant for bus powered devices is not provided. + * + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - The device mode Audio class driver now requires a new user application callback, \ref CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetInterfaceProperty(). + * Existing applications must implement this new callback, however if no audio entities are defined in the audio device's descriptors, + * this function may be hard-coded to always return false for previous behaviour to be retained. + * + * \section Sec_Migration111009 Migrating from 110528 to 111009 + * <b>Non-USB Library Components</b> + * - The \c JTAG_DEBUG_ASSERT() macro has been renamed \ref JTAG_ASSERT() to be consistent with \ref STDOUT_ASSERT(). + * + * <b>USB Core</b> + * - By default, unordered Endpoint and Pipe configuration is now allowed once again, via the previous workaround of + * reconfiguring all Endpoints/Pipes in order each time a new Endpoint/Pipe is created. To minimize the compiled program + * size, the new \c ORDERED_EP_CONFIG compile time option may be defined in the project makefile to restrict the ordering + * in exchange for a smaller compiled binary size. + * - The previous \c F_CLOCK symbol, required in the project makefile, has been renamed to \c F_USB. This is due to the previous name + * being far too generic for use in future architecture ports, where multiple clock domains are used. + * + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - The Endpoint stream functions now all require a \c BytesProcessed parameter instead of the previous callback parameter. + * This should be set to \c NULL to retain previous behaviour of the functions, or point to a location where the number of bytes + * processed in the current transaction can be stored. If the \c BytesProcessed parameter is non \c NULL, each time the endpoint + * bank becomes full and the packet is sent, the routine will exit with the new \ref ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer + * error code to allow the user application to determine when to send the next chunk of data. + * - The \ref CDC_Device_SendString() function now expects a null terminated string instead of an explicit length. Existing code + * should use the new \ref CDC_Device_SendData() function, or remove the length parameter from the function call. + * - The \c Endpoint_ResetFIFO() function has been renamed to \ref Endpoint_ResetEndpoint(), to make the API function names more + * consistent. Existing applications using the old function name should simply replace it with a call to the new function name. + * - The \c Endpoint_*_Byte() functions have been renamed Endpoint_*_8() to ensure they are correct across all architectures. Existing + * code using these functions should replace the previous function names with the new function names. + * - The \c Endpoint_*_Word() functions have been renamed Endpoint_*_16() to ensure they are correct across all architectures. Existing + * code using these functions should replace the previous function names with the new function names. + * - The \c Endpoint_*_DWord() functions have been renamed Endpoint_*_32() to ensure they are correct across all architectures. Existing + * code using these functions should replace the previous function names with the new function names. + * - The Device mode RNDIS class driver no longer stores the incoming and outgoing packets in the class driver instance; the user is + * now expected to manually define a storage location for the packet data. Packets must now be sent and received manually via a call + * to \ref RNDIS_Device_ReadPacket() and/or \ref RNDIS_Device_SendPacket(). + * - The definition of the Audio class \ref USB_Audio_Descriptor_Format_t has been altered, to remove the fixed singular + * audio sample rate in the descriptor definition, and to rename the \c SampleFrequencyType to the more appropriate + * \c TotalDiscreteSampleRates. Existing applications will need to add an array of \ref USB_Audio_SampleFreq_t elements + * immediately following any \ref USB_Audio_Descriptor_Format_t descriptors, and insert the appropriate sampling rates + * supported by the device, as well as rename the descriptor elements to match the updated element names. + * - The device mode Audio class driver now requires a new user application callback, \ref CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetEndpointProperty(). + * Existing applications must implement this new callback, however if multiple sample rates or pitch control is not used, + * this function may be hard-coded to always return false for previous behaviour to be retained. + * - The \c USB_ConfigurationNumber, \c USB_RemoteWakeupEnabled and \c USB_CurrentlySelfPowered globals have been renamed to + * \ref USB_Device_ConfigurationNumber, \ref USB_Device_RemoteWakeupEnabled and \ref USB_Device_CurrentlySelfPowered to clearly indicate + * the USB mode they relate to. Existing applications using these variables should rename all references to the previous names. + * - The \c ENDPOINT_DESCRIPTOR_DIR_IN and \c ENDPOINT_DESCRIPTOR_DIR_OUT macros have now been replaced by \ref ENDPOINT_DIR_IN and + * \ref ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT to improve code clarity. + * - The \ref HID_DESCRIPTOR_JOYSTICK() macro now takes an additional (first) parameter indicating the number of axis in the joystick. + * + * <b>Host Mode</b> + * - The Pipe stream functions now all require a \c BytesProcessed parameter instead of the previous callback parameter. + * This should be set to \c NULL to retain previous behaviour of the functions, or point to a location where the number of bytes + * processed in the current transaction can be stored. If the BytesProcessed parameter is non \c NULL, each time the pipe + * bank becomes full and the packet is sent, the routine will exit with the new \ref PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer + * error code to allow the user application to determine when to send the next chunk of data. + * - The \ref PRNT_Host_SendString() and \ref CDC_Host_SendString() functions now expect a null terminated string instead of an explicit + * length. Existing code should use the new \ref PRNT_Host_SendData() and \ref CDC_Host_SendData() functions, or remove the + * length parameter from the function call. + * - The \c Pipe_ClearErrorFlags() function has been removed, as the pipe error flags are now automatically cleared when the + * \ref Pipe_ClearError() function is called. + * - The \c Pipe_*_Byte() functions have been renamed Pipe_*_8() to ensure they are correct across all architectures. Existing code using + * these functions should replace the previous function names with the new function names. + * - The \c Pipe_*_Word() functions have been renamed Pipe_*_16() to ensure they are correct across all architectures. Existing code using + * these functions should replace the previous function names with the new function names. + * - The \c Pipe_*_DWord() functions have been renamed Pipe_*_32() to ensure they are correct across all architectures. Existing code using + * these functions should replace the previous function names with the new function names. + * - The \c USB_Host_ClearPipeStall() function has been renamed to USB_Host_ClearEndpointStall(), as it operates on a full endpoint address + * within the attached device and not a pipe within the host. Existing code using the old function name should update the function calls and + * check for correct usage. + * + * \section Sec_Migration101122 Migrating from 100807 to 101122 + * <b>USB Core</b> + * - A new USB driver source file, \c Drivers/USB/HighLevel/EndpointStream.c now exists. This source file should be added + * to all project makefiles using the USB driver of LUFA, or the makefile should be updated to use the new module source + * variables. + * - A new USB driver source file, \c Drivers/USB/HighLevel/PipeStream.c now exists. This source file should be added to all + * project makefiles using the USB driver of LUFA, or the makefile should be updated to use the new module source variables. + * - The \c EVENT_USB_InitFailure() event has been removed, as the \ref USB_Init() function will no longer fail; if not USB mode is + * specified, the controller will default to UID selection mode. + * - The USB mode specifier constants have been moved into a new enum and renamed. Existing projects should use the equivalent + * value in the new \ref USB_Modes_t enum. + * - All class driver headers are now included as part of the standard \c LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h master dispatch header, and should + * no longer be included separately. Class driver module source files must still be added as a separate module in the project's + * makefile if used. + * + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - Endpoints MUST be allocated in ascending order to ensure that bank corruption does not occur. Ensure that your user application + * allocated endpoints in ascending order - or if your application uses the USB device mode class drivers, ensure that each instance's + * endpoint indexes are not overlapped with other interface's endpoints. + * - The signature for the \ref CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor() callback has changed, the \c void** \c const \c DescriptorAddress parameter is + * now \c const \c void** \c const \c DescriptorAddress. Existing applications should update their callback signatures to match this, and + * eliminate any casting of descriptor pointers to a non \c const pointer. + * - The names of the class specific descriptor type defines in the USB Class drivers have changed - refer to the driver documentation + * for each class driver for the new class specific descriptor type names. + * - The \c ENDPOINT_DOUBLEBANK_SUPPORTED() macro is has been renamed \c ENDPOINT_BANKS_SUPPORTED() and now returns the total number of + * banks supported by the given endpoint. Existing code should switch to the new naming scheme, and test that the return value of the + * macro is equal to or greater than 2 to regain the previous functionality. + * - The \c EVENT_USB_Device_UnhandledControlRequest() event is now named \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() and fires before (not after) + * the internal library event handlers. Existing code should rename the event handlers in the user application to match the new event + * name, and should ensure that the new execution order does not affect the application's operation. + * + * <b>Host Mode</b> + * - Pipes MUST be allocated in ascending order to ensure that bank corruption does not occur. Ensure that your user application + * allocated pipes in ascending order - or if your application uses the USB host mode class drivers, ensure that each instance's + * pipe indexes are not overlapped with other interface's pipes. + * - The \c PRNT_Host_SendData() function has been renamed to \ref PRNT_Host_SendString(). Existing applications should simply + * replace all references to the obsolete function name with the new function name. + * - The names of the class specific descriptor type defines in the USB Class drivers have changed - refer to the driver documentation + * for each class driver for the new class specific descriptor type names. + * - The Still Image Host class' function prefix has been changed from \c SImage_ to \c SI_, to remain consistent with the rest of the + * driver's enums, type defines and constants. + * + * \section Sec_Migration100807 Migrating from 100513 to 100807 + * + * <b>Non-USB Library Components</b> + * - The Dataflash board driver stub file has changed, as dataflash functions previously located in the internal + * Dataflash driver of the library have now been moved to the individual board files. Existing drivers can + * copy-paste the new functions from the board Dataflash stub driver. + * + * <b>USB Core</b> + * - A new USB driver source file, \c Drivers/USB/LowLevel/Device.c now exists. This source file should be added to all project + * makefiles using the USB driver of LUFA, or the makefile should be updated to use the new module source variables. + * - The \c Drivers/USB/LowLevel/DevChapter9.c source file has moved to \c Drivers/USB/HighLevel/DeviceStandardReq.c - this should + * be updated in all project makefiles, or the makefile should be updated to use the new module source variables. + * - The \c Drivers/USB/LowLevel/HostChapter9.h source file has moved to \c Drivers/USB/HighLevel/HostStandardReq.c - this should + * be updated in all project makefiles, or the makefile should be updated to use the new module source variables. + * - The \c Drivers/USB/LowLevel/LowLevel.c source file has moved to \c Drivers/LowLevel/USBController.c - this should be updated + * in all project makefiles, or the makefile should be updated to use the new module source variables. + * + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - The \c USB_Device_IsRemoteWakeupSent() macro has been removed, as the remote wakeup request is now fully handled by the + * enhanced \ref USB_Device_SendRemoteWakeup() function. Existing code may now discard any checks to \c USB_Device_IsRemoteWakeupSent(). + * - The \c USB_Device_IsUSBSuspended() macro has been removed, as it is obsolete. Existing code should compare \ref USB_DeviceState + * to see if it the device is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Suspended state instead. + * - The \ref CDC_Device_ReceiveByte() function has changed, and now returns a signed 16-bit integer, with -1 indicating no data was + * received. This allows for more efficient coding, as a call to \ref CDC_Device_BytesReceived() is no longer needed if the exact + * number of queued bytes received is not needed. + * + * <b>Host Mode</b> + * - The \ref CDC_Host_ReceiveByte() function has changed, and now returns a signed 16-bit integer, with -1 indicating no data was + * received. This allows for more efficient coding, as a call to \ref CDC_Host_BytesReceived() is no longer needed if the exact + * number of queued bytes received is not needed. + * - The \ref CDC_Host_USBTask() now calls \ref CDC_Host_Flush() automatically, flushing any queued data to the attached device. Manual + * flushing of the interface is no longer needed if the flushes should be in sync with calls to \ref CDC_Host_USBTask(). + * + * \section Sec_Migration100513 Migrating from 100219 to 100513 + * + * <b>Non-USB Library Components</b> + * - The \ref TWI_StartTransmission() function now takes in a timeout period, expressed in milliseconds, within which the addressed + * device must respond or the function will abort. + * + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - The \ref USB_Init() function no longer calls \c sei() to enable global interrupts, as the user application may need + * to perform other initialization before it is ready to handle global interrupts. The user application is now responsible + * for enabling global interrupts before or shortly after calling \ref USB_Init() to ensure that the enumeration process + * functions correctly. + * - The \c USBInterrupt.c USB driver source file has been relocated from \c LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/ to \c LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel. + * Projects must update their makefile SRC values accordingly. + * - The HID Device Class driver's function signature for the \ref CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport() function has been changed, to + * allow for a new \c ReportType parameter. This new parameter must be added in all user applications using the Device mode HID Class + * Driver, but may be ignored unless Host-to-Device FEATURE HID reports are used. + * + * <b>Host Mode</b> + * - The \ref USB_Init() function no longer calls \c sei() to enable global interrupts, as the user application may need + * to perform other initialization before it is ready to handle global interrupts. The user application is now responsible + * for enabling global interrupts before or shortly after calling \ref USB_Init() to ensure that the enumeration process + * functions correctly. + * - The \c USBInterrupt.c USB driver source file has been relocated from \c LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/ to \c LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel. + * Projects must update their makefile \c SRC values accordingly. + * - The HID Host Class driver's function signature for the \ref HID_Host_SendReportByID() function has been changed, to allow for a new + * ReportType parameter. Existing calls to this function should substitute \c REPORT_ITEM_TYPE_Out as this parameter's value. + * + * \section Sec_Migration100219 Migrating from 091223 to 100219 + * + * <b>Non-USB Library Components</b> + * - Due to some ADC channels not being identical to their ADC MUX selection masks for single-ended conversions on some AVR models, + * the ADC driver now has explicit masks for each of the standard ADC channels (see \ref Group_ADC). These masks should be used + * when calling the ADC functions to ensure proper operation across all AVR models. Note that the \ref ADC_SetupChannel() function + * is an exception, and should always be called with a channel number rather than a channel mask. + * + * <b>Host Mode</b> + * - The MIDI Host Class driver send and receive routines now operate on packed events, where multiple MIDI events may be + * packed into a single USB packet. This means that the sending of MIDI events will now be delayed until the MIDI send + * pipe bank is full. To override this new behaviour and revert to the previous behaviour, the user application may manually + * flush the queued event(s) to the device by calling \ref MIDI_Host_Flush(). + * - The \ref Pipe_IsEndpointBound() function now takes the endpoint's direction into account, by checking if the MSB of the endpoint's address + * is set to denote IN endpoints. If the previous functionality where the direction is to be discounted is required, mask the endpoint + * address against the \ref PIPE_EPNUM_MASK token before calling \ref Pipe_IsEndpointBound(). + * + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - The MIDI Device Class driver send and receive routines now operate on packed events, where multiple MIDI events may be + * packed into a single USB packet. This means that the sending of MIDI events will now be delayed until the MIDI send + * endpoint bank is full. To override this new behaviour and revert to the previous behaviour, the user application may manually + * flush the queued event(s) to the host by calling \ref MIDI_Device_Flush(). + * + * \section Sec_Migration091223 Migrating from 091122 to 091223 + * + * <b>Host Mode</b> + * - The Still Image Host Class driver \ref SI_Host_USBTask() and \ref SI_Host_ConfigurePipes() functions were misnamed, and are + * now named \c SImage_Host_USBTask() and \c SImage_Host_ConfigurePipes() respectively. + * - The \c HOST_SENDCONTROL_DeviceDisconnect enum value has been renamed to \ref HOST_SENDCONTROL_DeviceDisconnected to be in + * line with the rest of the library error codes. + * - The HID Parser item usages no longer contain separate minimum and maximum values, as this was a violation of the HID + * specification. Instead, the values are distributed evenly across each item as its usage value, to ensure that all items + * can be distinguished from one-another. + * + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - The \ref CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport() HID Device Class driver callback now has a new \c ReportType parameter to + * indicate the report type to generate. Existing applications may simply add and ignore this additional parameter. + * + * \section Sec_Migration091122 Migrating from 090924 to 091122 + * + * <b>Host Mode</b> + * - The \c HID_PARSE_UsageStackOverflow HID parser error constant is now named \ref HID_PARSE_UsageListOverflow + * - The \ref CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem() HID Parser callback now passes a complete \ref HID_ReportItem_t to the + * user application, instead of just its attributes. + * - The \c USB_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor() function was incorrectly named and is now called \ref USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(). + * + * \section Sec_Migration090924 Migrating from 090810 to 090924 + * + * <b>Non-USB Library Components</b> + * - The \c ADC_Off() function has been renamed to \c ADC_ShutDown() to be consistent with the rest of the library. + * - The \ref SPI_Init() routine's parameters have changed, so that the clock polarity and data sampling modes can be set. See + * the \ref SPI_Init() function documentation for more details + * - The \ref Dataflash_Init() routine no longer initializes the SPI bus - the SPI bus should be initialized manually via a + * call to \ref SPI_Init() before using the Dataflash driver + * + * <b>Host Mode</b> + * - The \c USB_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor() function's parameters and behaviour has changed; the user is required to + * preallocate the largest allowable buffer, and pass the size of the buffer to the function. This allows for a single + * call to the function to retrieve, size check and validate the Configuration Descriptor rather than having the user + * application perform these intermediary steps. + * - The HID report parser now requires a mandatory callback in the user code, to filter only the items the application + * is interested in into the processed HID report item structure to save RAM. See \ref CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem(). + * - The HID report parser now always parses FEATURE and always ignores constant-data items - the \c HID_ENABLE_FEATURE_PROCESSING + * and \c HID_INCLUDE_CONSTANT_DATA_ITEMS compile time tokens now have no effect. + * - The \c USE_NONSTANDARD_DESCRIPTOR_NAMES compile time token has been removed - there are now separate \c USB_Descriptor_* + * and \c USB_StdDescriptor_* structures for both the LUFA and standardized element naming conventions so that both may be used in + * the one project. For existing projects using the standardized names, change all code to use the \c USB_StdDescriptor_* variants. + * + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - The \c USE_NONSTANDARD_DESCRIPTOR_NAMES compile time token has been removed - there are now separate \c USB_Descriptor_* + * and \c USB_StdDescriptor_* structures for both the LUFA and standardized element naming conventions so that both may be used in + * the one project. For existing projects using the standardized names, change all code to use the \c USB_StdDescriptor_* variants. + * + * \section Sec_Migration090810 Migrating from 090605 to 090810 + * + * <b>All</b> + * - The "Simple Scheduler" has been <i>deprecated</i>, as it was little more than an abstracted loop and caused much confusion. + * User applications using the scheduler should switch to regular loops instead. The scheduler code will be removed in a future + * release. + * - The "Dynamic Memory Block Allocator" has been removed, as it was unused in (and unrelated to) the LUFA library and never + * used in user applications. + * + * <b>Non-USB Library Components</b> + * - The \c ATTR_NOINLINE function attribute macro has been renamed to \ref ATTR_NO_INLINE to be in line with the rest of the function attribute + * macro names. + * + * <b>Library Demos</b> + * - Most demos now have a corresponding Class Driver implementation, which uses the new internal library class drivers for the standard + * USB classes. This allows for more rapid device and host development, and so should be used in preference to the low level APIs where + * possible so that fixes to the class drivers propagate to all applications which use them automatically with each new LUFA release. + * + * <b>Host Mode</b> + * - The \c HIDParser.c module has moved from \c LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/ to \c LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/. + * - The \c USB_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor() function now requires the desired configuration index within the device as its first + * parameter, to add support for multi-configuration devices. Existing code should use a configuration index of 1 to indicate the + * first configuration descriptor within the device. + * - The non-standard "Ready" host state has been removed. Existing \ref HOST_STATE_Configured code should be moved to the end of + * the existing \ref HOST_STATE_Addressed state, and the existing HOST_STATE_Ready state code should be moved to the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured + * state. + * - The \c USB_IsConnected global has been removed, as it is too vague for general use. Test \ref USB_HostState explicitly to ensure the host is + * in the desired state instead. + * - The USB event names have been changed and their firing conditions changed to properly separate out Host mode events from Device mode + * events. See the \ref Group_Events page for details on the new event names and firing conditions. + * + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - The \ref CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor() function now takes an extra parameter to specify the descriptor's memory space so that + * descriptors in mixed memory spaces can be used. The previous functionality can be returned by defining the \c USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS + * token in the project makefile to fix all descriptors into FLASH space and remove the extra function parameter. + * - The \c USB_IsSuspended global has been removed - test \ref USB_DeviceState against \ref DEVICE_STATE_Suspended instead. + * - The \c USB_IsConnected global has been removed, as it is too vague for general use. Test \ref USB_DeviceState explicitly to ensure the device + * is in the desired state instead. + * - The VBUS events have been removed, as they are already exposed to the user via the \c USB_Connect and \c USB_Disconnect events. + * - The USB event names have been changed and their firing conditions changed to properly separate out Host mode events from Device mode + * events. See the \ref Group_Events page for details on the new event names and firing conditions. + * + * \section Sec_Migration090605 Migrating from 090510 to 090605 + * + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - Support for non-control data endpoint interrupts has been dropped due to many issues in the implementation. All existing + * projects using interrupts on non-control endpoints should switch to polling. For control interrupts, the library can + * manage the control endpoint via interrupts automatically by compiling with the \c INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT token defined. + * - The \c DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS() macro has been removed. User applications should use normal casts to obtain a descriptor's memory + * address. + * - The library events system has been rewritten, so that all macros have been removed to allow for clearer user code. See + * \ref Group_Events for new API details. + * - The \c STREAM_CALLBACK() macro has been removed. User applications should replace all instances of the macro with regular + * function signatures of a function accepting no arguments and returning a \c uint8_t value. + * - The \c Event_DeviceError() event no longer exists, as its sole caller (unlinked \c USB_GetDescriptor() function) now produces a + * compilation error rather than a runtime error. The \c StdDescriptors.c file no longer exists as a result, and should be removed + * from project makefiles. + * - The \c USB_GetDescriptor() function has been renamed to \ref CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor() to be in line with the new \c CALLBACK_ + * function prefixes for functions which <i>must</i> be implemented in the user application. + * + * <b>Host Mode</b> + * - Support for non-control data pipe interrupts has been dropped due to many issues in the implementation. All existing + * projects using interrupts on non-control pipes should switch to polling. + * - The library events system has been rewritten, so that all macros have been removed to allow for clearer user code. See + * \ref Group_Events for new API details. + * - The \c STREAM_CALLBACK() macro has been removed. User applications should replace all instances of the macro with regular + * function signatures of a function accepting no arguments and returning a \c uint8_t value. + * - The \c DESCRIPTOR_COMPARATOR() macro has been removed. User applications should replace all instances of the macro with + * regular function signatures of a function accepting a void pointer to the descriptor to test, and returning a \c uint8_t value. + * + * \section Sec_Migration090510 Migrating from 090401 to 090510 + * + * <b>All</b> + * - The \c ButtLoadTag.h header has been removed, as it was never used for its intended purpose. Projects should either remove all + * \c BUTTLOADTAG() elements, or download and extract \c ButtLoadTag.h header from the ButtLoad project. + * - The \c Drivers/AT90USBXXX/ directory has been renamed to \c Drivers/Peripheral/. + * - The \c Serial_Stream driver has been renamed to \c SerialStream to remain consistent with the rest of the library naming scheme. + * - The HWB driver has changed to the \c Buttons driver. See the board Buttons driver documentation for the new API. + * + * <b>Dual Role Mode</b> + * - The \c USB_PowerOnFail event has been renamed to \c USB_InitFailure. + * - The functions in \c OTG.h have been renamed to remain more consistent with the library API. See the functions in \c OTG.h for more + * details. + * + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - The \c Endpoint_ClearCurrentBank() macro has been removed, and is now replaced with the \ref Endpoint_ClearIN(), \ref Endpoint_ClearOUT() + * macros. See \c Endpoint.h documentation for more details on the new endpoint management macros. + * - The \c Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed() macro has been renamed to \ref Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed() to be more consistent with the rest of + * the API naming scheme. + * - The \c Endpoint_IsSetupINReady() and \c Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived() macros have been renamed to \ref Endpoint_IsINReady() and + * \ref Endpoint_IsOUTReceived() respectively. + * - The \c Endpoint_IsSetupReceived() macro has been renamed to \ref Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived(). + * - The \c Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived() macro has been renamed to \ref Endpoint_ClearSETUP(). + * - All endpoint read/write/discard aliases which did not have an explicitly endianness specifier (such as \c Endpoint_Read_Word()) have + * been removed for clarity. Existing projects should use the \c _LE suffix on such calls to use the explicit Little Endian versions. + * - The \c USB_UnhandledControlPacket event no longer has any parameters. User code should no longer attempt to read in the remainder of + * the Control Request header as all Control Request header data is now preloaded by the library and made available in the + * USB_ControlRequest structure. + * - The \c FEATURELESS_CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE token has been renamed to \c CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE. + * - The \c STATIC_ENDPOINT_CONFIGURATION is no longer applicable as the library will apply this optimization when appropriate automatically. + * - The values of the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t and \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enums have had the \c ERROR_ portion + * of their names removed. + * + * <b>Host Mode</b> + * - The \ref USB_Host_SendControlRequest() function no longer automatically selects the Control pipe (pipe 0) to allow it to be used on + * other control type pipes. Care should be taken to ensure that the Control pipe is always selected before the function is called + * in existing projects where the Control pipe is to be operated on. + * - The USB Host management task now saves and restores the currently selected pipe before and after the task runs. Projects no longer + * need to manage this manually when calling the USB management task. + * - The \c Pipe_ClearCurrentBank() macro has been removed, and is now replaced with the Pipe_ClearIN(), Pipe_ClearOUT() macros. See + * Pipe.h documentation for more details on the new pipe management macros. + * - The \c Pipe_ReadWriteAllowed() macro has been renamed to \ref Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed() to be more consistent with the rest of the API + * naming scheme. + * - The \c Pipe_IsSetupINReceived() and \c Pipe_IsOutReady() macros have been renamed to \ref Pipe_IsINReceived() and \ref Pipe_IsOUTReady() + * respectively. + * - The new \ref Pipe_ClearSETUP() macro should be used to send SETUP transactions, rather than the previous \c Pipe_ClearSetupOUT() macro. + * - The \c Pipe_IsSetupSent() macro has been renamed to \ref Pipe_IsSETUPSent(). + * - The \c Pipe_ClearSetupSent() macro is no longer applicable and should be removed. + * - All pipe read/write/discard aliases which did not have an explicitly endianness specifier (such as \c Pipe_Read_Word()) have + * been removed for clarity. Existing projects should use the \c _LE suffix on such calls to use the explicit Little Endian versions. + * - The \c Host_IsResetBusDone() macro has been renamed to \c Host_IsBusResetComplete(). + * - The \c Pipe_Ignore_Word() and \c Pipe_Ignore_DWord() functions have been renamed to \c Pipe_Discard_Word() and \c Pipe_Discard_DWord() + * to remain consistent with the rest of the pipe API. + * - It is no longer needed to manually include the headers from \c LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class, as they are now included along with the rest + * of the USB headers when \c LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h is included. + * - Functions in the \c ConfigDescriptor.h header file no longer have \c Host_ as part of their names. + * - The \c ProcessHIDReport() has been renamed to \ref USB_ProcessHIDReport(), \c GetReportItemInfo() has been renamed to \ref USB_GetHIDReportItemInfo() + * and \c SetReportItemInfo() has been renamed to \ref USB_GetHIDReportItemInfo(). + * - The values of the \ref DSearch_Return_ErrorCodes_t and \ref DSearch_Comp_Return_ErrorCodes_t enums have had their respective \c Descriptor_Search + * and \c Descriptor_Search_Comp prefixes changed to all caps. + * - The \c USB_HostRequest global has been renamed to \ref USB_ControlRequest, and is used in Device mode also. The \c USB_Host_Request_Header_t + * structure type has been renamed to \ref USB_Request_Header_t. + * - The values of the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum have had the \c ERROR_ portion of their names removed. + * + * \section Sec_Migration090401 Migrating from 090209 to 090401 + * + * <b>All</b> + * - LUFA projects must now give the raw input clock frequency (before any prescaling) as a compile time constant \c F_USB, + * defined in the project makefile and passed to the compiler via the -D switch. + * - The makefile EEPROM programming targets for FLIP and dfu-programmer no longer program in the FLASH data in addition to the + * EEPROM data into the device. If both are to be programmed, both the EEPROM and FLASH programming targets must be called. + * - As the avr-libc macro has been corrected in recent avr-libc distributions, the \c SetSystemClockPrescaler() macro has been removed. + * Include \c <avr/power.h> and call \c clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); instead on recent avr-libc distributions. + * + * <b>Library Demos</b> + * - The USBtoSerial demo now discards all data when not connected to a host, rather than buffering it for later transmission. + * + * <b>Non-USB Library Components</b> + * - The \c ATTR_ALWAYSINLINE function attribute macro has been renamed to \ref ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE. + * - Custom board Dataflash drivers now require the implementation of \ref Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage() and \ref Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(). + * + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - The \c NO_CLEARSET_FEATURE_REQUEST compile time token has been renamed to \c FEATURELESS_CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE, and its function expanded + * to also remove parts of the Get Status chapter 9 request to further reduce code usage. On all applications currently using the + * \c NO_CLEARSET_FEATURE_REQUEST compile time token, it can be replaced with the \c FEATURELESS_CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE token with no further + * modifications required. + * + * \section Sec_Migration090209 Migrating from 081217 to 090209 + * + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - The \c ENDPOINT_MAX_ENDPOINTS constant has been renamed to the more appropriate name of \c ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS. + * - The \c USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS stream timeout default period has been extended to 100ms. This can be overridden in the user + * makefile if desired to restore the previous 50ms timeout. + * + * <b>Host Mode</b> + * - The \c PIPE_MAX_ENDPOINTS constant has been renamed to the more appropriate name of \c PIPE_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS. + * - The \c USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS stream timeout default period has been extended to 100ms. This can be overridden in the user + * makefile if desired to restore the previous 50ms timeout. + * - The \c USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event now contains a second \c SubErrorCode parameter, giving the error code of the function + * which failed. + * - The \c HID_PARSE_Sucessful enum member constant name has been corrected to \ref HID_PARSE_Successful. + * + * <b>Non-USB Library Components</b> + * - The previous \c SPI_SendByte() functionality is now located in \ref SPI_TransferByte(). \ref SPI_SendByte() now discards the return byte + * for speed, to compliment the new \ref SPI_ReceiveByte() function. If bidirectional SPI transfers are required, calls to \ref SPI_SendByte() + * should be changed to \ref SPI_TransferByte(). + * - The serial driver now sets the Tx line as an output explicitly, and enables the pull-up of the Rx line. + * - The \ref Serial_Init() and \c SerialStream_Init() functions now take a second \c DoubleSpeed parameter, which indicates if the USART + * should be initialized in double speed mode - useful in some circumstances for attaining baud rates not usually possible at the given AVR + * clock speed. + * + * \section Sec_Migration171208 Migrating from V1.5.3 to 081217 + * + * <b>All</b> + * - The MyUSB project name has been changed to LUFA (Lightweight Framework for USB AVRs). All references to MyUSB, including macro names, + * have been changed to LUFA. + * + * <b>Library Demos</b> + * - The ReconfigureUSART() routine in the USBtoSerial demo was not being called after new line encoding + * parameters were set by the host. Projects built on the USBtoSerial code should update to the latest version. + * - The HID Parser now supports multiple report (on a single endpoint) HID devices. The MouseHostWithParser and + * KeyboardHostWithPaser demos use the updated API functions to function correctly on such devices. Projects + * built on either "WithParser" demo should update to the latest code. + * - The RNDIS demo TCP stack has been modified so that connections can be properly closed. It is still not + * recommended that the MyUSB RNDIS demo TCP/IP stack be used for anything other than demonstration purposes, + * as it is neither a full nor a standards compliant implementation. + * + * <b>Non-USB Library Components</b> + * - The Serial_IsCharReceived() macro has been changed to the correct spelling of Serial_IsCharReceived() in Serial.h. + * + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - The MANUAL_PLL_CONTROL compile time token has been removed, and replaced with a USB_OPT_MANUAL_PLL mask + * to be used in the Options parameter of the USB_Init() function. + * - Calling USB_Init() now forces a complete USB interface reset and enumeration, even if the USB interface is + * currently initialized. + * - Interrupts are now disabled when processing control requests, to avoid problems with interrupts causing the library + * or user request processing code to exceed the strict USB timing requirements on control transfers. + * - The USB Reset event now resets and disables all device endpoints. If user code depends on endpoints remaining configured + * after a Reset event, it should be altered to explicitly re-initialize all user endpoints. + * - The prototype for the GetDescriptor function has been changed, as the return value was redundant. The function now + * returns the size of the descriptor, rather than passing it back via a parameter, or returns NO_DESCRIPTOR if the specified + * descriptor does not exist. + * - The NO_DESCRIPTOR_STRING macro has been renamed NO_DESCRIPTOR, and is now also used as a possible return value for the + * GetDescriptor function. + * + * <b>Host Mode</b> + * - The MANUAL_PLL_CONTROL compile time token has been removed, and replaced with a USB_OPT_MANUAL_PLL mask + * to be used in the Options parameter of the USB_Init() function. + * - The HID report parser now supports multiple Report IDs. The HID report parser GetReportItemInfo() and + * SetReportItemInfo() routines now return a boolean, set if the requested report item was located in the + * current report. If sending a report to a multi-report device, the first byte of the report is automatically + * set to the report ID of the given report item. + * - Calling USB_Init() now forces a complete USB interface reset and enumeration, even if the USB interface is + * currently initialized. + * + * \section Sec_Migration152 Migrating from V1.5.2 to V1.5.3 + * + * <b>Library Demos</b> + * - Previously, all demos contained a serial number string descriptor, filled with all zeros. A serial number + * string is required in Mass Storage devices, or devices which are to retain settings when moved between + * ports on a machine. As people were not changing the serial number value, this was causing conflicts and so + * the serial number descriptor has been removed from all but the Mass Storage demo, which requires it. + * - The AudioOut and AudioIn demos did not previously silence their endpoints when the host has deactivated + * them. Projects built upon either demo should upgrade to the latest code. + * - The FEATURE_ENDPOINT macro has been renamed FEATURE_ENDPOINT_HALT, and is now correctly documented. + * - The MassStoreHost demo contained errors which caused it to lock up randomly on certain devices. Projects built + * on the MassStoreDemo code should update to the latest version. + * - The Interrupt type endpoint in the CDC based demos previously had a polling interval of 0x02, which caused + * problems on some Linux systems. This has been changed to 0xFF, projects built on the CDC demos should upgrade + * to the latest code. + * - The HID keyboard and mouse demos were not previously boot mode compatible. To enable boot mode support, projects + * built on the keyboard or mouse demos (or derivatives) should upgrade to the latest code. + * - The Mass Storage demo was not previously standards compliant. Projects built on the Mass Storage demo should + * upgrade to the latest code. + * - The USART was not being reconfigured after the host sent new encoding settings in the USBtoSerial demo. This was + * previously discovered and fixed, but the change was lost. Projects built on the USBtoSerial demo should update + * to the latest code. + * + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - The endpoint non-control stream functions now have a default timeout of 50ms between packets in the stream. + * If this timeout is exceeded, the function returns the new ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_ERROR_Timeout error value. The + * timeout value can be overridden by defining the USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS in the project makefile to the desired + * timeout duration in ms. + * - Rather than returning fixed values, the flags indicating if the device has Remote Wakeup currently enabled + * and/or is self-powered are now accessed and set through the new USB_RemoteWakeupEnabled and + * USB_CurrentlySelfPowered macros. See the DevChapter9.h documentation for more details. + * - All endpoint stream functions now require an extra Callback function parameter. Existing code may be updated + * to either supply NO_STREAM_CALLBACK as the extra parameter, or disable stream callbacks altogether by passing + * the token NO_STREAM_CALLBACKS to the compiler using the -D switch. + * + * <b>Host Mode</b> + * - The pipe non-control stream functions now have a default timeout of 50ms between packets in the stream. + * If this timeout is exceeded, the function returns the new PIPE_RWSTREAM_ERROR_Timeout error value. The + * timeout value can be overridden by defining the USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS in the project makefile to the desired + * timeout duration in ms. + * - CollectionPath_t has been renamed to HID_CollectionPath_t to be more in line with the other HID parser structures. + * - All pipe stream functions now require an extra Callback function parameter. Existing code may be updated + * to either supply NO_STREAM_CALLBACK as the extra parameter, or disable stream callbacks altogether by passing + * the token NO_STREAM_CALLBACKS to the compiler using the -D switch. + * + * \section Sec_Migration151 Migrating from V1.5.1 to V1.5.2 + * + * <b>Library Demos</b> + * - The RNDIS demo application has been updated so that it is functional on Linux under earlier implementations + * of the RNDIS specification, which had non-standard behaviour. Projects built upon the demo should upgrade + * to the latest code. + * - The DFU class bootloader has had several bugs corrected in this release. It is recommended that where + * possible any existing devices upgrade to the latest bootloader code. + * + * \section Sec_Migration150 Migrating from V1.5.0 to V1.5.1 + * + * <b>Library Demos</b> + * - The USBtoSerial demo was broken in the 1.5.0 release, due to incorrect register polling in place of the + * global "Transmitting" flag. The change has been reverted in this release. Projects built upon the demo + * should upgrade to the latest code. + * - The HID class demos did not implement the mandatory GetReport HID class request. Projects built upon the HID + * demos should upgrade to the latest code. + * - The HID class demos incorrectly reported themselves as boot-protocol enabled HID devices in their descriptors. + * Projects built upon the HID demos should upgrade to the latest code. + * - The MIDI device demo had incorrect AudioStreaming interface descriptors. Projects built upon the MIDI demo + * should upgrade to the latest code. + * - The AudioOut demo did not correctly tristate the speaker pins when USB was disconnected, wasting power. + * Projects built upon the AudioOut demo should upgrade to the latest code. + * + * \section Sec_Migration141 Migrating from V1.4.1 to V1.5.0 + * + * <b>Library Demos</b> + * - Previous versions of the library demos had incorrectly encoded BCD version numbers in the descriptors. To + * avoid such mistakes in the future, the VERSION_BCD macro has been added to StdDescriptors.h. Existing + * projects should at least manually correct the BCD version numbers, or preferably update the descriptors to + * encode the version number in BCD format using the new macro. + * - The mandatory GetReport class-specific request was accidentally omitted from previous versions of the demos + * based on the Human Interface Device (HID) class. This has been corrected, and any user projects based on the + * HID demos should also be updated accordingly. + * - The CDC demos now correctly send an empty packet directly after a full packet, to end the transmission. + * Failure to do this on projects which always or frequently send full packets will cause buffering issues on + * the host OS. All CDC user projects are advised to update their transmission routines in the same manner as + * the library CDC demos. + * - The previous interrupt-driven Endpoint/Pipe demos did not properly save and restore the currently selected + * Endpoint/Pipe when the ISR fired. This has been corrected - user projects based on the interrupt driven + * demos should also update to properly save and restore the selected Endpoint/Pipe. + * + * <b>Non-USB Library Components</b> + * - The Atomic.h and ISRMacro.h header files in MyUSB/Common have been removed, as the library is now only + * compatible with avr-libc library versions newer than the time before the functionality of the deleted + * headers was available. + * + * <b>Device Mode</b> + * - The GetDescriptor function (see StdDescriptors.h) now has a new prototype, with altered parameter names and + * functions. Existing projects will need to update the GetDescriptor implementation to reflect the new API. + * The previously split Type and Index parameters are now passed as the original wValue parameter to the + * function, to make way for the USB specification wIndex parameter which is <i>not</i> the same as the + * previous Index parameter. + * - The USB_UnhandledControlPacket event (see Events.h) now has new parameter names, to be in line with the + * official USB specification. Existing code will need to be altered to use the new parameter names. + * - The USB_CreateEndpoints event (see Events.h) has been renamed to USB_ConfigurationChanged, which is more + * appropriate. It fires in an identical manner to the previously named event, thus the only change to be made + * is the event name itself in the user project. + * - The USB_Descriptor_Language_t structure no longer exists in StdDescriptors.h, as this was a + * pseudo-descriptor modeled on the string descriptor. It is replaced by the true USB_Descriptor_String_t type + * descriptor as indicated in the USB specification, thus all device code must be updated accordingly. + * - The names of several Endpoint macros have been changed to be more consistent with the rest of the library, + * with no implementation changes. This means that existing code can be altered to use the new macro names + * with no other considerations required. See Endpoint.h for the new macro names. + * - The previous version of the MassStorage demo had an incorrect value in the SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t + * structure named SenseData in SCSI.c which caused some problems with some hosts. User projects based on this + * demo should correct the structure value to maintain compatibility across multiple OS platforms. + * - By default, the descriptor structures use the official USB specification names for the elements. Previous + * versions of the library used non-standard (but more verbose) names, which are still usable in the current + * and future releases when the correct compile time option is enabled. See the StdDescriptors.h file + * documentation for more details. + * + * <b>Host Mode</b> + * - The USB_Host_Request_Header_t structure in HostChapter9.h (used for issuing control requests) has had its + * members renamed to the official USB specification names for requests. Existing code will need to be updated + * to use the new names. + * - The names of several Pipe macros have been changed to be more consistent with the rest of the library, + * with no implementation changes. This means that existing code can be altered to use the new macro names + * with no other considerations required. See Pipe.h for the new macro names. + * - By default, the descriptor structures use the official USB specification names for the elements. Previous + * versions of the library used non-standard (but more verbose) names, which are still usable in the current + * and future releases when the correct compile time option is enabled. See the StdDescriptors.h file + * documentation for more details. + * - The names of the macros in Host.h for controlling the SOF generation have been renamed, see the Host.h + * module documentation for the new macro names. + * + * <b>Dual Role Mode</b> + * - The OTG.h header file has been corrected so that the macros now perform their stated functions. Any existing + * projects using custom headers to fix the broken OTG header should now be altered to once again use the OTG + * header inside the library. + * - The USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event (see Events.h) now also fires in Device mode, when the host has + * finished enumerating the device. Projects relying on the event only firing in Host mode should be updated + * so that the event action only occurs when the USB_Mode global is set to USB_MODE_HOST. + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/OSDrivers.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/OSDrivers.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4823c5b089 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/OSDrivers.txt @@ -0,0 +1,111 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \page Page_OSDrivers Operating System Drivers + * + * Most of the USB classes supported by LUFA are also supported natively in + * most operating systems, without extra drivers being required. However, in + * some cases, a driver file is required in order for the device to enumerate + * and function correctly. + * + * \section Sec_OSClassSupport Operating System USB Class Support + * The table below lists the supported LUFA USB classes, and their associated + * <i>native</i> support on modern operating systems. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th width="200px">USB Class</th> + * <th width="150px">Android</th> + * <th width="150px">Windows</th> + * <th width="150px">Linux</th> + * <th width="150px">OS X</th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Android Open Accessory</td> + * <td>2.3.4+</td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Audio 1.0</td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>XP+</td> + * <td>2.6.?+</td> + * <td>10.?+</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>CDC-ACM</td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>XP+</td> + * <td>2.6.?+</td> + * <td>10.?+</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>HID</td> + * <td>3.?+</td> + * <td>XP+</td> + * <td>2.6.?+</td> + * <td>10.?+</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MIDI</td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>XP+</td> + * <td>2.6.?+</td> + * <td>10.?+</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Mass Storage</td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>XP+</td> + * <td>2.6.?+</td> + * <td>10.?+</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Printer</td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>XP+</td> + * <td>2.6.?+</td> + * <td>10.?+</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>RNDIS</td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>XP+</td> + * <td>2.6.?+</td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Still Image</td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>XP+</td> + * <td>2.6.?+</td> + * <td>10.?+</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_WinINFTemplates Windows INF Drivers + * Windows uses INF driver files to associate a USB device of a specific class, + * VID/PID ID pair, Windows Compatibility ID or other characteristic to a kernel + * driver. In most cases these files are build into the operating system, and + * no special user action or driver files are required for a device using a + * standard USB class to enumerate. However, for some classes, a specific INF + * driver must be created and given to the operating system for the device to + * enumerate. + * + * Those USB classes requiring a custom INF driver file in Windows are listed + * below, along with a basic INF template for each class. + * + * \subsection SSec_WinINF_CDC Windows CDC INF Template + * This template is required for all CDC-ACM devices on Windows XP or newer. + * \verbinclude "WindowsINF/LUFA CDC-ACM.inf" + * + * \subsection SSec_WinINF_RNDIS Windows RNDIS INF Template + * This template is required for all RNDIS devices on Windows XP or newer. + * \verbinclude "WindowsINF/LUFA RNDIS.inf" + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/ProgrammingApps.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/ProgrammingApps.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..653b4ad04b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/ProgrammingApps.txt @@ -0,0 +1,27 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \page Page_ProgrammingApps Programming an Application into a USB AVR + * + * Once you have built an application, you will need a way to program in the resulting ".HEX" file (and, if your + * application uses EEPROM variables with initial values, also a ".EEP" file) into your USB AVR. Normally, the + * reprogramming of an AVR device must be performed using a special piece of programming hardware, through one of the + * supported AVR programming protocols - ISP, HVSP, HVPP, JTAG, dW or PDI. This can be done through a custom programmer, + * a third party programmer, or an official Atmel AVR tool - for more information, see the <a>atmel.com</a> website. + * + * Alternatively, you can use the bootloader. From the Atmel factory, each USB AVR comes preloaded with the Atmel + * DFU (Device Firmware Update) class bootloader, a small piece of AVR firmware which allows the remainder of the + * AVR to be programmed through a non-standard interface such as the serial USART port, SPI, or (in this case) USB. + * Bootloaders have the advantage of not requiring any special hardware for programming, and cannot usually be erased + * or broken without an external programming device. They have disadvantages however; they cannot change the fuses of + * the AVR (special configuration settings that control the operation of the chip itself) and a small portion of the + * AVR's FLASH program memory must be reserved to contain the bootloader firmware, and thus cannot be used by the + * loaded application. + * + * If you wish to use the DFU bootloader to program in your application, refer to your DFU programmer's documentation. + * Atmel provides a free utility called FLIP which is USB AVR compatible, and an open source (Linux compatible) + * alternative exists called "dfu-programmer". + */ diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/SoftwareBootloaderJump.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/SoftwareBootloaderJump.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f8c2523d7b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/SoftwareBootloaderJump.txt @@ -0,0 +1,71 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** + * \page Page_SoftwareBootloaderStart Entering the Bootloader via Software + * + * A common requirement of many applications is the ability to jump to the programmed bootloader of a chip + * on demand, via the code's firmware (i.e. not as a result of any physical user interaction with the + * hardware). This might be required because the device does not have any physical user input, or simply + * just to streamline the device upgrade process on the host PC. + * + * The following C code snippets may be used to enter the bootloader upon request by the user application. + * By using the watchdog to physically reset the controller, it is ensured that all system hardware is + * completely reset to their defaults before the bootloader is run. This is important; since bootloaders + * are written to occupy a very limited space, they usually make assumptions about the register states based + * on the default values after a hard-reset of the chip. + * + * \section Sec_SoftareBootAVR8 AVR8 Architecture + * The following software bootloader jump code is written for the AVR8 architecture. + * + * \code + * #include <avr/wdt.h> + * #include <avr/io.h> + * #include <util/delay.h> + * + * #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + * #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + * + * uint32_t Boot_Key ATTR_NO_INIT; + * + * #define MAGIC_BOOT_KEY 0xBADCAFE5 + * #define BOOTLOADER_START_ADDRESS ((FLASH_SIZE_BYTES - BOOTLOADER_SEC_SIZE_BYTES) >> 1) + * + * void Bootloader_Jump_Check(void) ATTR_INIT_SECTION(3); + * void Bootloader_Jump_Check(void) + * { + * // If the reset source was the bootloader and the key is correct, clear it and jump to the bootloader + * if ((MCUSR & (1 << WDRF)) && (Boot_Key == MAGIC_BOOT_KEY)) + * { + * Boot_Key = 0; + * ((void (*)(void))BOOTLOADER_START_ADDRESS)(); + * } + * } + * + * void Jump_To_Bootloader(void) + * { + * // If USB is used, detach from the bus and reset it + * USB_Disable(); + * + * // Disable all interrupts + * cli(); + * + * // Wait two seconds for the USB detachment to register on the host + * Delay_MS(2000); + * + * // Set the bootloader key to the magic value and force a reset + * Boot_Key = MAGIC_BOOT_KEY; + * wdt_enable(WDTO_250MS); + * for (;;); + * } + * \endcode + * + * Note that the bootloader magic key can be any arbitrary value. The <em>FLASH_SIZE_BYTES</em> and + * <em>BOOTLOADER_SEC_SIZE_BYTES</em> tokens should be replaced with the total flash size of the AVR + * in bytes, and the allocated size of the bootloader section for the target AVR. + * + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Style/Footer.htm b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Style/Footer.htm new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a72c5bdd24 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Style/Footer.htm @@ -0,0 +1,35 @@ +<!--BEGIN GENERATE_TREEVIEW--> + <div id="nav-path" class="navpath"><!-- id is needed for treeview function! --> + <ul> + <li class="footer" style="float:left !important;"> + $generatedby + <a href="http://www.doxygen.org/index.html"> + <img class="footer" src="$relpath$doxygen.png" alt="doxygen"/> + </a> + $doxygenversion + </li> + + <li class="footer"> + <a href="http://www.lufa-lib.org" title="LUFA Project Page">LUFA Project Page</a> | <a href="http://www.lufa-lib.org/support" title="LUFA Support List">Support Mailing List</a> | <a href="http://www.lufa-lib.org/donate" title="Donate to Support LUFA">Donate</a> | <a href="http://www.fourwalledcubicle.com" title="Four Walled Cubicle Website">Four Walled Cubicle</a> - LUFA, the Lightweight USB Framework for AVRs + </li> + </ul> + </div> +<!--END GENERATE_TREEVIEW--> +<!--BEGIN !GENERATE_TREEVIEW--> + <hr class="footer"/> + <div class="footer"> + <span style="float: left;"> + $generatedby + <a href="http://www.doxygen.org/index.html"> + <img class="footer" src="$relpath$doxygen.png" alt="doxygen"/> + </a> + $doxygenversion + </span> + + <span style="margin-right: 20px; float: right;"> + <a href="http://www.lufa-lib.org" title="LUFA Project Page">LUFA Project Page</a> | <a href="http://www.lufa-lib.org/support" title="LUFA Support List">Support Mailing List</a> | <a href="http://www.lufa-lib.org/donate" title="Donate to Support LUFA">Donate</a> | <a href="http://www.fourwalledcubicle.com" title="Four Walled Cubicle Website">Four Walled Cubicle</a> - LUFA, the Lightweight USB Framework for AVRs + </span> + </div> +<!--END !GENERATE_TREEVIEW--> + </body> +</html>
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Style/Style.css b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Style/Style.css new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..933215546f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/Style/Style.css @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* ============================= */ +/* Page Header Formattings */ +/* ============================= */ +#titlearea { + background-color:#E1E7F4; + background-image:url('nav_f.png'); + background-repeat:repeat-x; + color:#20335A; + font-weight:bold; + text-shadow:0 1px 1px rgba(255, 255, 255, 0.9); +} + +#projectlogo { + padding-left: 10px; +} + +/* ============================= */ +/* General Text Formattings */ +/* ============================= */ +body,table,div,p,dl { + font-family:Lucida Grande, Verdana, Geneva, Arial, sans-serif; + font-size:13px; + line-height:1.3; +} + +div.header, div.contents p { + padding-left:12px; +} + +/* ============================= */ +/* API Documentation Formattings */ +/* ============================= */ +div.contents table.memberdecls, .paramname { + font-family:Consolas, Monaco, courier, sans-serif; + font-size:105%; + padding-right:20px; +} + +/* ============================= */ +/* HTML Heading Formattings */ +/* ============================= */ +h1, h2, h3, h4 { + font-family:Lucida Grande, Verdana, Geneva, Arial, sans-serif; +} + +h1 { + font-size:25px; + margin-bottom:10px; +} + +h2 { + color:#42657B; + font-size:17px; +} + +h3 { + font-size:15px; +} + +h4 { + font-size:13px; +} + +/* ============================= */ +/* Code Snippet Formattings */ +/* ============================= */ +span.keyword { + color:#008000; +} + +span.keywordtype { + color:#604020; +} + +span.keywordflow { + color:#e08000; +} + +span.comment { + color:#008000; +} + +span.preprocessor { + color:#806020; +} + +span.stringliteral { + color:#002080; +} + +span.charliteral { + color:#008080; +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/VIDAndPIDValues.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/VIDAndPIDValues.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8b17220445 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/VIDAndPIDValues.txt @@ -0,0 +1,199 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \page Page_VIDPID VID and PID values + * + * \section Sec_VIDPID_Allocations VID and PID Allocations + * The LUFA library uses VID/PID combinations generously donated by Atmel. The following VID/PID combinations + * are used within the LUFA demos, and thus may be re-used by derivations of each demo. Free PID values may be + * used by future LUFA demo projects. + * + * <b>These VID/PID values should not be used in commercial designs under any circumstances.</b> Private projects + * may use the following values freely, but must accept any collisions due to other LUFA derived private projects + * sharing identical values. It is suggested that private projects using interfaces compatible with existing + * demos share the same VID/PID value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th>VID</th> + * <th>PID</th> + * <th>Usage</th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x2040</td> + * <td>Test VID/PID (See \ref Sec_Test_VIDPID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x2041</td> + * <td>Mouse Demo Application</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x2042</td> + * <td>Keyboard Demo Application</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x2043</td> + * <td>Joystick Demo Application</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x2044</td> + * <td>CDC Demo Application</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x2045</td> + * <td>Mass Storage Demo Application</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x2046</td> + * <td>Audio Output Demo Application</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x2047</td> + * <td>Audio Input Demo Application</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x2048</td> + * <td>MIDI Demo Application</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x2049</td> + * <td>MagStripe Project</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x204A</td> + * <td>CDC Class Bootloader</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x204B</td> + * <td>USB to Serial Demo Application</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x204C</td> + * <td>RNDIS Demo Application</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x204D</td> + * <td>Combined Keyboard and Mouse Demo Application</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x204E</td> + * <td>Dual CDC Demo Application</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td> + * 0x204F + * </td> + * <td>Generic HID Demo Application</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x2060</td> + * <td>Benito Programmer Project</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x2061</td> + * <td>Combined Mass Storage and Keyboard Demo</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x2062</td> + * <td>Combined CDC and Mouse Demo</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x2063</td> + * <td>Mass Storage/HID Interface Datalogger Project</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x2064</td> + * <td>Interfaceless Control-Only LUFA Devices</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x2065</td> + * <td>Test and Measurement Demo</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td> + * 0x2066 + * </td> + * <td>Multiple Report Keyboard/Mouse HID Demo</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x2067</td> + * <td>HID Class Bootloader</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x2068</td> + * <td>Virtual Serial/Mass Storage Demo</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td> + * 0x2069 + * </td> + * <td>Webserver Project</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x206A</td> + * <td>Media Control Project</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x206B</td> + * <td>Printer Class Bootloader</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x206C</td> + * <td>Bulk Vendor Demo Application</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x206D</td> + * <td>Dual MIDI Demo Application</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x206E</td> + * <td><i>Currently Unallocated</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>0x03EB</td> + * <td>0x206F</td> + * <td><i>Currently Unallocated</i></td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Test_VIDPID The Test VID/PID Combination + * For use in testing of LUFA powered devices during development only, by non-commercial entities. + * All devices must accept collisions on this VID/PID range (from other in-development LUFA devices) + * to be resolved by using a unique release number in the Device Descriptor. No devices using this + * VID/PID combination may be released to the general public. + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/WritingBoardDrivers.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/WritingBoardDrivers.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b2ff07e666 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/DoxygenPages/WritingBoardDrivers.txt @@ -0,0 +1,47 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \page Page_WritingBoardDrivers Writing LUFA Board Drivers + * + * LUFA ships with several basic pre-made board drivers, to control hardware present on the supported board + * hardware - such as Dataflash ICs, LEDs, Joysticks, or other hardware peripherals. When compiling an application + * which makes use of one or more board drivers located in <i>LUFA/Drivers/Board</i>, you must also indicate which + * board hardware you are using in your project makefile. This is done by defining the <tt>BOARD</tt> macro using + * the <tt>-D</tt> switch passed to the compiler, with a constant of <tt>BOARD_{Name}</tt>. For example, + * <tt>-DBOARD=BOARD_USBKEY</tt> instructs the compiler to use the USBKEY board hardware drivers. + * + * If your application does not use <i>any</i> board level drivers, you can omit the definition of the <tt>BOARD</tt> + * macro. However, some users may wish to write their own custom board hardware drivers which are to remain compatible + * with the LUFA hardware API. To do this, the <tt>BOARD</tt> macro should be defined to the value <tt>BOARD_USER</tt>. + * This indicates that the board level drivers should be located in a folder named "Board" located inside the + * application's folder. + * + * When used, the driver stub files located in the <tt>LUFA/CodeTemplates/DriverStubs</tt> folder should be copied to + * the user application's <tt>Board/</tt> directory, and filled out to include the values and code needed to control + * the custom board hardware. Once done, the existing LUFA board level APIs (accessed in the regular + * <tt>LUFA/Drivers/Board/</tt> folder) will redirect to the user board drivers, maintaining code compatibility and + * allowing for a different board to be selected through the project makefile with no code changes. + * + * \section Sec_BoardTemplates Board Driver Templates + * + * The templates for each board driver are reproduced below. + * + * \subsection SSec_BoardTemplates_Board Template for USER <Board/Board.h> + * \include "DriverStubs/Board.h" + * + * \subsection SSec_BoardTemplates_Buttons Template for USER <Board/Buttons.h> + * \include "DriverStubs/Buttons.h" + * + * \subsection SSec_BoardTemplates_Dataflash Template for USER <Board/Dataflash.h> + * \include "DriverStubs/Dataflash.h" + * + * \subsection SSec_BoardTemplates_Joystick Template for USER <Board/Joystick.h> + * \include "DriverStubs/Joystick.h" + * + * \subsection SSec_BoardTemplates_LEDs Template for USER <Board/LEDs.h> + * \include "DriverStubs/LEDs.h" + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/ADAFRUITU4/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/ADAFRUITU4/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a640ddcc2f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/ADAFRUITU4/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Adafruit U4 Breakout board. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_ADAFRUITU4 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_ADAFRUITU4 ADAFRUITU4 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Adafruit U4 Breakout board. + * + * Board specific information header for the Adafruit U4 Breakout board (http://ladyada.net/products/atmega32u4breakout). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_ADAFRUITU4_H__ +#define __BOARD_ADAFRUITU4_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/ADAFRUITU4/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/ADAFRUITU4/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..be7180c052 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/ADAFRUITU4/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,135 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Adafruit U4 Breakout board. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_ADAFRUITU4 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_ADAFRUITU4 ADAFRUITU4 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Adafruit U4 Breakout board. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Adafruit U4 Breakout board (http://ladyada.net/products/atmega32u4breakout). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTE.6</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_ADAFRUITU4_H__ +#define __LEDS_ADAFRUITU4_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRE |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTE &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRE &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTE &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTE |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTE &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTE = ((PORTE & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTE = ((PORTE & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINE = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (PORTE & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/ATAVRUSBRF01/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/ATAVRUSBRF01/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..11e6e0e676 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/ATAVRUSBRF01/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel ATAVRUSBRF01. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_ATAVRUSBRF01 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_ATAVRUSBRF01 ATAVRUSBRF01 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel ATAVRUSBRF01. + * + * Board specific information header for the Atmel ATAVRUSBRF01. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_ATAVRUSBRF01_H__ +#define __BOARD_ATAVRUSBRF01_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/ATAVRUSBRF01/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/ATAVRUSBRF01/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7d5a48bb9a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/ATAVRUSBRF01/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel ATAVRUSBRF01. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_ATAVRUSBRF01 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_ATAVRUSBRF01 ATAVRUSBRF01 + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel ATAVRUSBRF01. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel ATAVRUSBRF01. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_ATAVRUSBRF01_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_ATAVRUSBRF01_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 7) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PIND & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/ATAVRUSBRF01/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/ATAVRUSBRF01/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cd7bff7885 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/ATAVRUSBRF01/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,139 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel ATAVRUSBRF01. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_ATAVRUSBRF01 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_ATAVRUSBRF01 ATAVRUSBRF01 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel ATAVRUSBRF01. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel ATAVRUSBRF01. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>RX LED</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.0</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Red</td><td>TX LED</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.1</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_ATAVRUSBRF01_H__ +#define __LEDS_ATAVRUSBRF01_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 0) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 1) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD |= (LEDMask & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD = (PORTD & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | (LEDMask & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PIND = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (PORTD & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BENITO/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BENITO/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9f5b291aa3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BENITO/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Tempusdictum Benito. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_BENITO + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_BENITO BENITO + * \brief Board specific information header for the Tempusdictum Benito. + * + * Board specific information header for the Tempusdictum Benito (http://dorkbotpdx.org/wiki/benito). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_BENITO_H__ +#define __BOARD_BENITO_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BENITO/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BENITO/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5e9128eb34 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BENITO/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Tempusdictum Benito. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_BENITO + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_BENITO BENITO + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Tempusdictum Benito. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Tempusdictum Benito (http://dorkbotpdx.org/wiki/benito). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_BENITO_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_BENITO_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 7) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PIND & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BENITO/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BENITO/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f968d7ce89 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BENITO/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,139 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Tempusdictum Benito. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_BENITO + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_BENITO BENITO + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Tempusdictum Benito. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Tempusdictum Benito (http://dorkbotpdx.org/wiki/benito). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>TX LED</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTC.7</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Red</td><td>RX LED</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTC.6</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_BENITO_H__ +#define __LEDS_BENITO_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 7) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRC |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTC |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRC &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTC &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTC &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTC |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTC = ((PORTC | LEDS_ALL_LEDS) & ~LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTC = ((PORTC | LEDMask) & ~ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINC = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (~PORTC & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BIGMULTIO/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BIGMULTIO/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..02ebe0941c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BIGMULTIO/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Bitwizard Big-Multio. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_BIGMULTIO + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_BIGMULTIO BIGMULTIO + * \brief Board specific information header for the Bitwizard Big-Multio. + * + * Board specific information header for the Bitwizard Big-Multio (http://www.bitwizard.nl/wiki/index.php/Usbbigmultio). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_BIGMULTIO_H__ +#define __BOARD_BIGMULTIO_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BIGMULTIO/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BIGMULTIO/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..93048f5640 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BIGMULTIO/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,161 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Bitwizard Big-Multio. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_BIGMULTIO + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_BIGMULTIO BIGMULTIO + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Bitwizard Big-Multio. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Bitwizard Big-Multio (http://www.bitwizard.nl/wiki/index.php/Usbbigmultio). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Unknown</td><td>LED0</td><td>High</td><td>PORTF.6</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Unknown</td><td>LED1</td><td>High</td><td>PORTF.7</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Unknown</td><td>LED2</td><td>High</td><td>PORTE.2</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_BIGMULTIO_H__ +#define __LEDS_BIGMULTIO_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define LEDS_PORTF_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + #define LEDS_PORTE_LEDS LEDS_LED3 + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 7) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 2) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRF |= LEDS_PORTF_LEDS; + DDRE |= LEDS_PORTE_LEDS; + + PORTF &= ~LEDS_PORTF_LEDS; + PORTE &= ~LEDS_PORTE_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRF &= ~LEDS_PORTF_LEDS; + DDRE &= ~LEDS_PORTE_LEDS; + + PORTF &= ~LEDS_PORTF_LEDS; + PORTE &= ~LEDS_PORTE_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTF |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTF_LEDS); + PORTE |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTF &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTF_LEDS); + PORTE &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTF = (PORTF & ~LEDS_PORTF_LEDS) | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTF_LEDS); + PORTE = (PORTE & ~LEDS_PORTE_LEDS) | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTF = (PORTF & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTF_LEDS)) | (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTF_LEDS); + PORTE = (PORTE & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS)) | (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINF = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTF_LEDS); + PINE = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS); + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return ((PORTF & LEDS_PORTF_LEDS) | (PORTE & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BLACKCAT/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BLACKCAT/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a9aef6e9eb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BLACKCAT/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the BLACKCAT USB JTAG. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_BLACKCAT + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_BLACKCAT BLACKCAT + * \brief Board specific information header for the BLACKCAT USB JTAG. + * + * Board specific information header for the TCNISO Blackcat USB JTAG (http://www.embeddedcomputers.net/products/BlackcatUSB). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_BLACKCAT_H__ +#define __BOARD_BLACKCAT_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BLACKCAT/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BLACKCAT/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5a7c4f2332 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BLACKCAT/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,139 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the BLACKCAT USB JTAG. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_BLACKCAT + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_BLACKCAT BLACKCAT + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the BLACKCAT USB JTAG. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the TCNISO Blackcat USB JTAG (http://www.embeddedcomputers.net/products/BlackcatUSB). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Unknown</td><td>LED0</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.6</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Unknown</td><td>LED1</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.3</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_BLACKCAT_H__ +#define __LEDS_BLACKCAT_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 3) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PIND = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (PORTD & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUI/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUI/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..87102b60f7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUI/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Busware BUI. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_BUI + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_BUI BUI + * \brief Board specific information header for the Busware BUI. + * + * Board specific information header for the Busware BUI (http://www.busware.de/tiki-index.php?page=BUI). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_BUI_H__ +#define __BOARD_BUI_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUI/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUI/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d982bcd67d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUI/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,143 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Busware BUI. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_BUI + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_BUI BUI + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Busware BUI. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Busware BUI (http://www.busware.de/tiki-index.php?page=BUI). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Red</td><td>RGB LED</td><td>High</td><td>PORTC.2</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Green</td><td>RGB LED</td><td>High</td><td>PORTC.3</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Blue</td><td>RGB LED</td><td>High</td><td>PORTC.4</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_BUI_H__ +#define __LEDS_BUI_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + +/* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 2) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 3) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 4) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRC |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTC &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRC &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTC &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTC |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTC &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTC = (PORTC & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTC = (PORTC & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINC = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (PORTC & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUMBLEB/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUMBLEB/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5af60abe1b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUMBLEB/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,86 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Fletchtronics BUMBLEB. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_BUMBLEB + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_BUMBLEB BUMBLEB + * \brief Board specific information header for the Fletchtronics BUMBLEB. + * + * Board specific information header for the Fletchtronics BUMBLEB (http://fletchtronics.net/bumble-b). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_BUMBLEB_H__ +#define __BOARD_BUMBLEB_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../Joystick.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Joystick mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_JOYSTICK + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUMBLEB/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUMBLEB/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..812cf79246 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUMBLEB/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,105 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Fletchtronics BUMBLEB. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_BUMBLEB + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_BUMBLEB BUMBLEB + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Fletchtronics BUMBLEB. + * + * Board specific buttons driver header for the Fletchtronics BUMBLEB (http://fletchtronics.net/bumble-b). The BUMBLEB + * third-party board does not include any on-board peripherals, but does have an officially recommended external peripheral + * layout for buttons, LEDs and a Joystick. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_BUMBLEB_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_BUMBLEB_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 7) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PIND & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUMBLEB/Joystick.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUMBLEB/Joystick.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..259c674d6e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUMBLEB/Joystick.h @@ -0,0 +1,123 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific joystick driver header for the Fletchtronics BUMBLEB. + * \copydetails Group_Joystick_BUMBLEB + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the joystick driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Joystick + * \defgroup Group_Joystick_BUMBLEB BUMBLEB + * \brief Board specific joystick driver header for the Fletchtronics BUMBLEB. + * + * Board specific joystick driver header for the Fletchtronics BUMBLEB (http://fletchtronics.net/bumble-b). The BUMBLEB + * third-party board does not include any on-board peripherals, but does have an officially recommended external peripheral + * layout for buttons, LEDs and a Joystick. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Left Port Pin</th><th>Up Port Pin</th><th>Right Port Pin</th><th>Down Port Pin</th><th>Press Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>PORTD.2</td><td>PORTD.3</td><td>PORTD.0</td><td>PORTD.1</td><td>PORTD.4</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __JOYSTICK_BUMBLEB_H__ +#define __JOYSTICK_BUMBLEB_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_JOYSTICK_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define JOY_MASK ((1 << 0) | (1 << 1) | (1 << 2) | (1 << 3) | (1 << 4)) + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the left direction. */ + #define JOY_LEFT (1 << 2) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the upward direction. */ + #define JOY_UP (1 << 3) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the right direction. */ + #define JOY_RIGHT (1 << 0) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the downward direction. */ + #define JOY_DOWN (1 << 1) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed inward. */ + #define JOY_PRESS (1 << 4) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Joystick_Init(void) + { + DDRD &= ~JOY_MASK; + PORTD |= JOY_MASK; + } + + static inline void Joystick_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~JOY_MASK; + PORTD &= ~JOY_MASK; + } + + static inline uint8_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) + { + return (uint8_t)(~PIND & JOY_MASK); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUMBLEB/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUMBLEB/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bb070db970 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUMBLEB/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,149 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Fletchtronics BUMBLEB. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_BUMBLEB + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_BUMBLEB BUMBLEB + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Fletchtronics BUMBLEB. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Fletchtronics BUMBLEB (http://fletchtronics.net/bumble-b). The BUMBLEB + * third-party board does not include any on-board peripherals, but does have an officially recommended external + * peripheral layout for buttons, LEDs and a Joystick. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>N/A</td><td>User Supplied</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.4</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>N/A</td><td>User Supplied</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>N/A</td><td>User Supplied</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.6</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED4</td><td>N/A</td><td>User Supplied</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_BUMBLEB_H__ +#define __LEDS_BUMBLEB_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 4) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for the fourth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED4 (1 << 7) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRB |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTB &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRB &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTB &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LedMask) + { + PORTB |= LedMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LedMask) + { + PORTB &= ~LedMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LedMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LedMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LedMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB & ~LedMask) | ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINB = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (PORTB & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/CULV3/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/CULV3/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..88679d1b84 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/CULV3/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Busware CUL V3. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_CULV3 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_CULV3 CULV3 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Busware CUL V3. + * + * Board specific information header for the Busware CUL V3 (http://busware.de/tiki-index.php?page=CUL). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_CULV3_H__ +#define __BOARD_CULV3_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/CULV3/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/CULV3/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..21b6e1c08b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/CULV3/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Busware CULV3. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_CULV3 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_CULV3 CULV3 + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Busware CULV3. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Busware CUL V3 (http://busware.de/tiki-index.php?page=CUL). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTE.2</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_CULV3_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_CULV3_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 2) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTE |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PINE & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/CULV3/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/CULV3/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..da3ebf85f9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/CULV3/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,135 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Busware CUL V3. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_CULV3 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_CULV3 CULV3 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Busware CUL V3. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Busware CUL V3 (http://busware.de/tiki-index.php?page=CUL). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Yellow</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTE.6</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_CULV3_H__ +#define __LEDS_CULV3_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRE |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTE &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRE &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTE &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTE |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTE &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTE = ((PORTE & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTE = ((PORTE & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINE = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (PORTE & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/DUCE/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/DUCE/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8521ec9bd6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/DUCE/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the DorkbotPDX Duce. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_DUCE + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_DUCE DUCE + * \brief Board specific information header for the DorkbotPDX Duce. + * + * Board specific information header for the DorkbotPDX Duce (http://dorkbotpdx.org/wiki/duce). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_DUCE_H__ +#define __BOARD_DUCE_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/DUCE/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/DUCE/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ad866b96d8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/DUCE/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,147 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the DorkbotPDX Duce. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_DUCE + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_DUCE DUCE + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the DorkbotPDX Duce. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the DorkbotPDX Duce (http://dorkbotpdx.org/wiki/duce). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Red</td><td>Bicolor Indicator 1</td><td>High</td><td>PORTC.4</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Green</td><td>Bicolor Indicator 1</td><td>High</td><td>PORTC.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Red</td><td>Bicolor Indicator 2</td><td>High</td><td>PORTC.6</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED4</td><td>Green</td><td>Bicolor Indicator 2</td><td>High</td><td>PORTC.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_DUCE_H__ +#define __LEDS_DUCE_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 4) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for the fourth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED4 (1 << 7) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRC |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTC &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRC &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTC &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTC |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTC &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTC = ((PORTC & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTC = ((PORTC & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINC = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (PORTC & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..01b6b93ff0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,90 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel EVK527. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_EVK527 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_EVK527 EVK527 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel EVK527. + * + * Board specific information header for the Atmel EVK527. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_EVK527_H__ +#define __BOARD_EVK527_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../Dataflash.h" + #include "../../Joystick.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Dataflash mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_DATAFLASH + + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Joystick mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_JOYSTICK + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3094fbe0e0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel EVK527. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_EVK527 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_EVK527 EVK527 + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel EVK527. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel EVK527. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTE.2</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_EVK527_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_EVK527_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 2) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTE |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PINE & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/Dataflash.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/Dataflash.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2ec973e233 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/Dataflash.h @@ -0,0 +1,222 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Dataflash driver header for the Atmel EVK527. + * \copydetails Group_Dataflash_EVK527 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the dataflash driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Dataflash + * \defgroup Group_Dataflash_EVK527 EVK527 + * \brief Board specific Dataflash driver header for the Atmel EVK527. + * + * Board specific Dataflash driver header for the Atmel EVK527. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Select Pin</th><th>SPI Port</th></tr> + * <tr><td>DATAFLASH_CHIP1</td><td>AT45DB321C (4MB)</td><td>PORTE.6</td><td>SPI0</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __DATAFLASH_EVK527_H__ +#define __DATAFLASH_EVK527_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../../Misc/AT45DB321C.h" + #include "../../../Peripheral/SPI.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_DATAFLASH_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK DATAFLASH_CHIP1 + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_DDR DDRE + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT PORTE + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Constant indicating the total number of dataflash ICs mounted on the selected board. */ + #define DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS 1 + + /** Mask for no dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP 0 + + /** Mask for the first dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIP1 (1 << 6) + + /** Internal main memory page size for the board's dataflash IC. */ + #define DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE 512 + + /** Total number of pages inside the board's dataflash IC. */ + #define DATAFLASH_PAGES 8192 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initializes the dataflash driver so that commands and data may be sent to an attached dataflash IC. + * The appropriate SPI interface will be automatically configured. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_Init(void) + { + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_DDR |= DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK; + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT |= DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK; + + SPI_Init(SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_2 | SPI_ORDER_MSB_FIRST | SPI_SCK_LEAD_FALLING | SPI_SAMPLE_TRAILING | SPI_MODE_MASTER); + } + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns a byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + return SPI_TransferByte(Byte); + } + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and ignores the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + SPI_SendByte(Byte); + } + + /** Sends a dummy byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) + { + return SPI_ReceiveByte(); + } + + /** Determines the currently selected dataflash chip. + * + * \return Mask of the currently selected Dataflash chip, either \ref DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP if no chip is selected + * or a DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is the chip number). + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) + { + return (~DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT & DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK); + } + + /** Selects the given dataflash chip. + * + * \param[in] ChipMask Mask of the Dataflash IC to select, in the form of a \c DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is + * the chip number). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) + { + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT = ((DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT | DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK) & ~ChipMask); + } + + /** Deselects the current dataflash chip, so that no dataflash is selected. */ + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) + { + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP); + } + + /** Selects a dataflash IC from the given page number, which should range from 0 to + * ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). For boards containing only one + * dataflash IC, this will select DATAFLASH_CHIP1. If the given page number is outside + * the total number of pages contained in the boards dataflash ICs, all dataflash ICs + * are deselected. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Address of the page to manipulate, ranging from + * 0 to ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(const uint16_t PageAddress) + { + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + if (PageAddress >= DATAFLASH_PAGES) + return; + + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + } + + /** Toggles the select line of the currently selected dataflash IC, so that it is ready to receive + * a new command. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(void) + { + uint8_t SelectedChipMask = Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(); + + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + Dataflash_SelectChip(SelectedChipMask); + } + + /** Spin-loops while the currently selected dataflash is busy executing a command, such as a main + * memory page program or main memory to buffer transfer. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(void) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + while (!(Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_READY)); + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + } + + /** Sends a set of page and buffer address bytes to the currently selected dataflash IC, for use with + * dataflash commands which require a complete 24-bit address. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Page address within the selected dataflash IC + * \param[in] BufferByte Address within the dataflash's buffer + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(uint16_t PageAddress, + const uint16_t BufferByte) + { + Dataflash_SendByte(PageAddress >> 5); + Dataflash_SendByte((PageAddress << 3) | (BufferByte >> 8)); + Dataflash_SendByte(BufferByte); + } + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/Joystick.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/Joystick.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..909fa02c58 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/Joystick.h @@ -0,0 +1,130 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific joystick driver header for the Atmel EVK527. + * \copydetails Group_Joystick_EVK527 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the joystick driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Joystick + * \defgroup Group_Joystick_EVK527 EVK527 + * \brief Board specific joystick driver header for the Atmel EVK527. + * + * Board specific joystick driver header for the Atmel EVK527. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Left Port Pin</th><th>Up Port Pin</th><th>Right Port Pin</th><th>Down Port Pin</th><th>Press Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>PORTF.4</td><td>PORTF.5</td><td>PORTF.7</td><td>PORTC.6</td><td>PORTF.6</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __JOYSTICK_EVK527_H__ +#define __JOYSTICK_EVK527_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_JOYSTICK_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define JOY_FMASK ((1 << 4) | (1 << 5) | (1 << 6) | (1 << 7)) + #define JOY_CMASK (1 << 6) + + #define JOY_PORTC_MASK_SHIFT 3 + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the left direction. */ + #define JOY_LEFT (1 << 4) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the right direction. */ + #define JOY_RIGHT (1 << 7) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the upward direction. */ + #define JOY_UP (1 << 5) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the downward direction. */ + #define JOY_DOWN ((1 << 6) >> JOY_PORTC_MASK_SHIFT) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed inward. */ + #define JOY_PRESS (1 << 6) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Joystick_Init(void) + { + DDRF &= ~JOY_FMASK; + DDRC &= ~JOY_CMASK; + + PORTF |= JOY_FMASK; + PORTC |= JOY_CMASK; + } + + static inline void Joystick_Disable(void) + { + DDRF &= ~JOY_FMASK; + DDRC &= ~JOY_CMASK; + + PORTF &= ~JOY_FMASK; + PORTC &= ~JOY_CMASK; + } + + static inline uint8_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) + { + return (((uint8_t)~PINF & JOY_FMASK) | (((uint8_t)~PINC & JOY_CMASK) >> JOY_PORTC_MASK_SHIFT)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a10b8229e0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,143 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel EVK527. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_EVK527 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_EVK527 EVK527 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel EVK527. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel EVK527. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.6</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_EVK527_H__ +#define __LEDS_EVK527_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 7) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PIND = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (PORTD & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/JMDBU2/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/JMDBU2/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0e46a578b8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/JMDBU2/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Mattairtech JM-DB-U2. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_JMDBU2 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_JMDBU2 JMDBU2 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Mattairtech JM-DB-U2. + * + * Board specific information header for the Mattairtech JM-DB-U2 (http://u2.mattair.net/index.html). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_JMDBU2_H__ +#define __BOARD_JMDBU2_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/JMDBU2/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/JMDBU2/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8da45e402e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/JMDBU2/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Mattairtech JM-DB-U2. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_JMDBU2 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_JMDBU2 JMDBU2 + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Mattairtech JM-DB-U2. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Mattairtech JM-DB-U2 (http://u2.mattair.net/index.html). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_JMDBU2_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_JMDBU2_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 7) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PIND & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/JMDBU2/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/JMDBU2/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bd2c191a5a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/JMDBU2/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,135 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Mattairtech JM-DB-U2. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_JMDBU2 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_JMDBU2 JMDBU2 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Mattairtech JM-DB-U2. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Mattairtech JM-DB-U2 (http://u2.mattair.net/index.html). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.4</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_JMDBU2_H__ +#define __LEDS_JMDBU2_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 4) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PIND = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (PORTD & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/LEONARDO/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/LEONARDO/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..400bb11c4a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/LEONARDO/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Arduino Leonardo board. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_LEONARDO + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_LEONARDO LEONARDO + * \brief Board specific information header for the Arduino Leonardo board. + * + * Board specific information header for the Arduino Leonardo board (http://arduino.cc/en/Main/arduinoBoardLeonardo). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_LEONARDO_H__ +#define __BOARD_LEONARDO_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/LEONARDO/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/LEONARDO/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6f26cc1820 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/LEONARDO/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,169 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Arduino Leonardo board. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_LEONARDO + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_LEONARDO LEONARDO + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Arduino Leonardo board. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Arduino Leonardo board (http://arduino.cc/en/Main/arduinoBoardLeonardo). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Yellow</td><td>RX</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTB.0</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Yellow</td><td>TX</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Yellow</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTC.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_LEONARDO_H__ +#define __LEDS_LEONARDO_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define LEDS_PORTB_LEDS (LEDS_LED1) + #define LEDS_PORTD_LEDS (LEDS_LED2) + #define LEDS_PORTC_LEDS (LEDS_LED3) + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 0) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 7) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRB |= LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + PORTB |= LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + DDRD |= LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + PORTD |= LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + DDRC |= LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + PORTC &= ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRB &= ~LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + PORTB &= ~LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + DDRD &= ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + DDRC &= ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + PORTC &= ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTD &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PORTC |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTD |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PORTC &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB | LEDS_PORTB_LEDS) & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS)); + PORTD = ((PORTD | LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS)); + PORTC = ((PORTC & ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS) | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS)); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS)) & ~(ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS)); + PORTD = ((PORTD | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS)) & ~(ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS)); + PORTC = ((PORTC & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS)) | (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS)); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINB = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PIND = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PINC = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS); + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return ((~PORTB & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS) | (~PORTD & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) | (PORTC & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MAXIMUS/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MAXIMUS/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7de7501e43 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MAXIMUS/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Maximus board. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_MAXIMUS + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_MAXIMUS MAXIMUS + * \brief Board specific information header for the Maximus board. + * + * Board specific information header for the Maximus (http://www.avrusb.com/). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_MAXIMUS_H__ +#define __BOARD_MAXIMUS_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MAXIMUS/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MAXIMUS/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..aba85abd46 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MAXIMUS/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,139 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Maximus. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_MAXIMUS + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_MAXIMUS MAXIMUS + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Maximus. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Maximus (http://www.avrusb.com/). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>LG</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.6</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Red</td><td>LR</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_MAXIMUS_H__ +#define __LEDS_MAXIMUS_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 7) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + + /** LED mask for the none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRB |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTB &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRB &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTB &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINB = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (PORTB & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICRO/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICRO/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..279dc3aafe --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICRO/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Arduino Micro board. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_MICRO + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_MICRO MICRO + * \brief Board specific information header for the Arduino Micro board. + * + * Board specific information header for the Arduino Micro board (http://arduino.cc/en/Main/arduinoBoardMicro). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_MICRO_H__ +#define __BOARD_MICRO_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICRO/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICRO/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..445e1a3347 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICRO/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,169 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Arduino Micro board. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_MICRO + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_MICRO MICRO + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Arduino Micro board. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Arduino Micro board (http://arduino.cc/en/Main/arduinoBoardMicro). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Yellow</td><td>RX</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.0</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Yellow</td><td>TX</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTC.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_MICRO_H__ +#define __LEDS_MICRO_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define LEDS_PORTB_LEDS (LEDS_LED1) + #define LEDS_PORTD_LEDS (LEDS_LED2) + #define LEDS_PORTC_LEDS (LEDS_LED3) + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 0) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 7) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRB |= LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + PORTB &= ~LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + DDRD |= LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + DDRC |= LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + PORTC &= ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRB &= ~LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + PORTB &= ~LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + DDRD &= ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + DDRC &= ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + PORTC &= ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTD |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PORTC |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTD &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PORTC &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB & ~LEDS_PORTB_LEDS) | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS)); + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS)); + PORTC = ((PORTC & ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS) | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS)); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS)) | (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS)); + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS)) | (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS)); + PORTC = ((PORTC & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS)) | (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS)); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB ^= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTD ^= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PORTC ^= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS); + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return ((PORTB & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS) | (PORTD & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) | (PORTC & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1ae3d6f200 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,149 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Micropendous series boards. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_A MICROPENDOUS_A + * \brief Board specific information header for the Micropendous A (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/MicropendousA). + * + * See \ref Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_1 MICROPENDOUS_1 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Micropendous 1 (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/Micropendous1). + * + * See \ref Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_2 MICROPENDOUS_2 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Micropendous 2 (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/Micropendous2). + * + * See \ref Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_3 MICROPENDOUS_3 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Micropendous 3 (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/Micropendous3). + * + * See \ref Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_4 MICROPENDOUS_4 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Micropendous 4 (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/Micropendous4). + * + * See \ref Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_DIP MICROPENDOUS_DIP + * \brief Board specific information header for the Micropendous DIP (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/MicropendousDIP). + * + * See \ref Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_REV1 MICROPENDOUS_REV1 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Micropendous Arduino-like Revision 1 (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/Micropendous). + * + * See \ref Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_REV2 MICROPENDOUS_REV2 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Micropendous Arduino-like Revision 2 (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/Micropendous). + * + * See \ref Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 MICROPENDOUS_32U2 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Micropendous series boards. + * + * Board specific information header for the Micropendous series boards (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_H__ +#define __BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + #if ((BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_32U2) || (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_A) || \ + (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_1) || (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_2) || \ + (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_3) || (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_4) || \ + (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV1) || (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV2) || \ + (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_DIP) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + #include "../../Buttons.h" + + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + #endif + + #if ((BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV1) || (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV2) || \ + (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_32U2) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c40ac1fe7c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,205 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Micropendous series boards. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_MICROPENDOUS_A MICROPENDOUS_A + * \brief Board specific Button driver header for the Micropendous A (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/MicropendousA). + * + * See \ref Group_Buttons_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_MICROPENDOUS_1 MICROPENDOUS_1 + * \brief Board specific Button driver header for the Micropendous 1 (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/Micropendous1). + * + * See \ref Group_Buttons_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_MICROPENDOUS_2 MICROPENDOUS_2 + * \brief Board specific Button driver header for the Micropendous 2 (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/Micropendous2). + * + * See \ref Group_Buttons_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_MICROPENDOUS_3 MICROPENDOUS_3 + * \brief Board specific Button driver header for the Micropendous 3 (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/Micropendous3). + * + * See \ref Group_Buttons_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_MICROPENDOUS_4 MICROPENDOUS_4 + * \brief Board specific Button driver header for the Micropendous 4 (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/Micropendous4). + * + * See \ref Group_Buttons_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_MICROPENDOUS_DIP MICROPENDOUS_DIP + * \brief Board specific Button driver header for the Micropendous DIP (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/MicropendousDIP). + * + * See \ref Group_Buttons_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_MICROPENDOUS_REV1 MICROPENDOUS_REV1 + * \brief Board specific Button driver header for the Micropendous Arduino-like Revision 1 (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/Micropendous). + * + * See \ref Group_Buttons_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_MICROPENDOUS_REV2 MICROPENDOUS_REV2 + * \brief Board specific Button driver header for the Micropendous Arduino-like Revision 2 (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/Micropendous). + * + * See \ref Group_Buttons_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 MICROPENDOUS_32U2 + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Micropendous 32U2. + * + * \note There are multiple supported Micropendous boards, compile with <code>BOARD = MICROPENDOUS_{VERSION}</code>. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Micropendous 32U2 (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/Micropendous_32U2). + * + * <b>BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_1 and BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_32U2</b>: + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * <b>Other Revisions</b>: + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTE.2</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_MICROPENDOUS_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_MICROPENDOUS_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #if (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_32U2) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON1_MASK (1 << 7) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON_PORTLETTER D + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_A) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON1_MASK (1 << 2) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON_PORTLETTER E + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_1) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON1_MASK (1 << 7) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON_PORTLETTER D + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_2) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON1_MASK (1 << 2) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON_PORTLETTER E + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_3) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON1_MASK (1 << 2) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON_PORTLETTER E + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_4) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON1_MASK (1 << 2) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON_PORTLETTER E + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_DIP) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON1_MASK (1 << 2) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON_PORTLETTER E + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV1) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON1_MASK (1 << 2) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON_PORTLETTER E + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV2) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON1_MASK (1 << 2) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON_PORTLETTER E + #endif + + #define _BOARD_BUTTON_PORT CONCAT_EXPANDED(PORT, _BOARD_BUTTON_PORTLETTER) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON_PIN CONCAT_EXPANDED(PIN, _BOARD_BUTTON_PORTLETTER) + #define _BOARD_BUTTON_DDR CONCAT_EXPANDED(DDR, _BOARD_BUTTON_PORTLETTER) + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 _BOARD_BUTTON1_MASK + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + _BOARD_BUTTON_DDR &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + _BOARD_BUTTON_PORT |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + _BOARD_BUTTON_DDR &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + _BOARD_BUTTON_PORT &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((_BOARD_BUTTON_PIN & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2ab89eb5b1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,174 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Micropendous series boards. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_MICROPENDOUS_REV1 MICROPENDOUS_REV1 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Micropendous Arduino-like Revision 1 (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/Micropendous). + * + * See \ref Group_LEDs_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_MICROPENDOUS_REV2 MICROPENDOUS_REV2 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Micropendous Arduino-like Revision 2 (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/Micropendous). + * + * See \ref Group_LEDs_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_MICROPENDOUS_32U2 MICROPENDOUS_32U2 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Micropendous-32U2. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Micropendous 32U2 (https://code.google.com/p/micropendous/wiki/Micropendous_32U2). + * + * <b>BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_32U2</b>: + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.6</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * <b>Other Revisions</b>: + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.1</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_MICROPENDOUS_H__ +#define __LEDS_MICROPENDOUS_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #if (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_32U2) + #define _BOARD_LED1_MASK (1 << 6) + #define _BOARD_LED_PORTLETTER D + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV1) + #define _BOARD_LED1_MASK (1 << 1) + #define _BOARD_LED_PORTLETTER B + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV2) + #define _BOARD_LED1_MASK (1 << 1) + #define _BOARD_LED_PORTLETTER B + #endif + + #define _BOARD_LED_PORT CONCAT_EXPANDED(PORT, _BOARD_LED_PORTLETTER) + #define _BOARD_LED_PIN CONCAT_EXPANDED(PIN, _BOARD_LED_PORTLETTER) + #define _BOARD_LED_DDR CONCAT_EXPANDED(DDR, _BOARD_LED_PORTLETTER) + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 _BOARD_LED1_MASK + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + _BOARD_LED_DDR |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + _BOARD_LED_PORT &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + _BOARD_LED_DDR &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + _BOARD_LED_PORT &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + _BOARD_LED_PORT |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + _BOARD_LED_PORT &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + _BOARD_LED_PORT = ((_BOARD_LED_PORT & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + _BOARD_LED_PORT = ((_BOARD_LED_PORT & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + _BOARD_LED_PIN = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (_BOARD_LED_PORT & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROSIN162/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROSIN162/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1e503c3c8a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROSIN162/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Microsin AVR-USB162 board. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_MICROSIN162 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_MICROSIN162 MICROSIN162 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Microsin AVR-USB162 board. + * + * Board specific information header for the Microsin AVR-USB162 board (http://microsin.ru/content/view/685/44/). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_MICROSIN162_H__ +#define __BOARD_MICROSIN162_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROSIN162/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROSIN162/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1c90fab1e9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROSIN162/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Microsin AVR-USB162 board. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_MICROSIN162 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_MICROSIN162 MICROSIN162 + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Microsin AVR-USB162 board. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Microsin AVR-USB162 board (http://microsin.ru/content/view/685/44/). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_MICROSIN162_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_MICROSIN162_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 7) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PIND & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROSIN162/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROSIN162/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..690ce7df8d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROSIN162/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,135 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Microsin AVR-USB162 board. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_MICROSIN162 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_MICROSIN162 MICROSIN162 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Microsin AVR-USB162 board. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Microsin AVR-USB162 board (http://microsin.ru/content/view/685/44/). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.4</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_MICROSIN162_H__ +#define __LEDS_MICROSIN162_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 4) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD | LEDS_ALL_LEDS) & ~LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD | LEDMask) & ~ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PIND = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (~PORTD & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MINIMUS/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MINIMUS/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..53bc2daf57 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MINIMUS/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the MINIMUS. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_MINIMUS + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_MINIMUS MINIMUS + * \brief Board specific information header for the MINIMUS. + * + * Board specific information header for the MINIMUS. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_MINIMUS_H__ +#define __BOARD_MINIMUS_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MINIMUS/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MINIMUS/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f83924c52e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MINIMUS/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the MINIMUS. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_MINIMUS + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_MINIMUS MINIMUS + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the MINIMUS. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the MINIMUS. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_MINIMUS_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_MINIMUS_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 7) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PIND & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MINIMUS/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MINIMUS/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5569323081 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MINIMUS/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,139 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the MINIMUS. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_MINIMUS + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_MINIMUS MINIMUS + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the MINIMUS. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Minimus USB (http://www.minimususb.com/). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Blue</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Red</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.6</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_MINIMUS_H__ +#define __LEDS_MINIMUS_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + + /** LED mask for the none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD | LEDS_ALL_LEDS) & ~LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PIND = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (~PORTD & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MULTIO/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MULTIO/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d701dc31b2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MULTIO/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Bitwizard Multio. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_MULTIO + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_MULTIO MULTIO + * \brief Board specific information header for the Bitwizard Multio. + * + * Board specific information header for the Bitwizard Multio (http://www.bitwizard.nl/wiki/index.php/USB-multio). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_MULTIO_H__ +#define __BOARD_MULTIO_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MULTIO/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MULTIO/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9d3bf6a49f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/MULTIO/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,161 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Bitwizard Multio. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_MULTIO + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_MULTIO MULTIO + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Bitwizard Multio. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Bitwizard Multio (http://www.bitwizard.nl/wiki/index.php/USB-multio). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.0</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTC.2</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_MULTIO_H__ +#define __LEDS_MULTIO_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define LEDS_PORTD_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + #define LEDS_PORTC_LEDS LEDS_LED2 + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 0) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 2) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 7) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRD |= LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + DDRC |= LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + + PORTD &= ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + PORTC &= ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + DDRC &= ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + + PORTD &= ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + PORTC &= ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PORTC |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PORTC &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD = (PORTD & ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PORTC = (PORTC & ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS) | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTD = (PORTD & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS)) | (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PORTC = (PORTC & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS)) | (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PIND = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PINC = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS); + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return ((PORTD & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) | (PORTC & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX162/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX162/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..64c657758a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX162/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Olimex AVR-USB-162 Development Board. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_OLIMEX162 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_OLIMEX162 OLIMEX162 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Olimex AVR-USB-162 Development Board. + * + * Board specific information header for the Olimex AVR-USB-162 Development Board (http://www.olimex.com/dev/avr-usb-162.html). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_OLIMEX162_H__ +#define __BOARD_OLIMEX162_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX162/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX162/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f8ed8714d5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX162/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Olimex AVR-USB-162 Development Board. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_OLIMEX162 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_OLIMEX162 OLIMEX162 + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Olimex AVR-USB-162 Development Board. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Olimex AVR-USB-162 Development Board (http://www.olimex.com/dev/avr-usb-162.html). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_OLIMEX162_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_OLIMEX162_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 7) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PIND & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX162/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX162/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..52d82ef96a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX162/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,135 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Olimex AVR-USB-162. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_OLIMEX162 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_OLIMEX162 OLIMEX162 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Olimex AVR-USB-162. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Olimex AVR-USB-162 (http://www.olimex.com/dev/avr-usb-162.html). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Yellow</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.4</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_OLIMEX162_H__ +#define __LEDS_OLIMEX162_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 4) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PIND = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (PORTD & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX32U4/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX32U4/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f063b9f9e7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX32U4/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Olimex AVR-USB-32U4 Development Board. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_OLIMEX32U4 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_OLIMEX32U4 OLIMEX32U4 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Olimex AVR-USB-32U4 Development Board. + * + * Board specific information header for the Olimex AVR-USB-32U4 Development Board (http://www.olimex.com/dev/olimexino-32u4.html). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_OLIMEX32U4_H__ +#define __BOARD_OLIMEX32U4_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX32U4/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX32U4/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fecc637043 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX32U4/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Olimex AVR-USB-32U4 Development Board. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_OLIMEX32U4 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_OLIMEX32U4 OLIMEX32U4 + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Olimex AVR-USB-32U4 Development Board. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Olimex AVR-USB-32U4 Development Board (http://www.olimex.com/dev/olimexino-32u4.html). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTE.2</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_OLIMEX32U4_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_OLIMEX32U4_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 2) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTE |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PINE & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX32U4/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX32U4/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..51eeaceab5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX32U4/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,179 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Olimex AVR-USB-32U4. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_OLIMEX32U4 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_OLIMEX32U4 OLIMEX32U4 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Olimex AVR-USB-32U4. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Olimex AVR-USB-32U4 (http://www.olimex.com/dev/olimexino-32u4.html). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>TX</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Yellow</td><td>RX</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.0</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator (Default Unconnected)</td><td>High</td><td>PORTE.6</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED4</td><td>Yellow</td><td>General Indicator (Default Unconnected)</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.5</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_OLIMEX32U4_H__ +#define __LEDS_OLIMEX32U4_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define LEDS_PORTB_LEDS (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + #define LEDS_PORTD_LEDS (LEDS_LED1) + #define LEDS_PORTE_LEDS (LEDS_LED3) + + #define LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT 1 + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 ((1 << 5) >> LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 0) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for the fourth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED4 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRB |= LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + PORTB &= ~LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + DDRD |= (LEDS_PORTD_LEDS << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT); + PORTD &= ~(LEDS_PORTD_LEDS << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT); + DDRE |= LEDS_PORTE_LEDS; + PORTE &= ~LEDS_PORTE_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRB &= ~LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + PORTB &= ~LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + DDRD &= ~(LEDS_PORTD_LEDS << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT); + PORTD &= ~(LEDS_PORTD_LEDS << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT); + DDRE &= ~LEDS_PORTE_LEDS; + PORTE &= ~LEDS_PORTE_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTD |= ((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT); + PORTE |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTD &= ~((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT); + PORTE &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB & ~LEDS_PORTB_LEDS) | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS)); + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~(LEDS_PORTD_LEDS << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT)) | + ((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT)); + PORTE = ((PORTE & ~LEDS_PORTE_LEDS) | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS)); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS)) | (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS)); + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT)) | + ((ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT)); + PORTE = ((PORTE & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS)) | (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS)); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINB = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PIND = ((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT); + PINE = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS); + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return ((PORTB & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS) | + ((PORTD & (LEDS_PORTD_LEDS << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT)) >> LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT) | + (PORTE & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXISPMK2/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXISPMK2/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..52129fb739 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXISPMK2/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Olimex AVR-ISP-MK2 Development Board. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_OLIMEXISPMK2 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_OLIMEXISPMK2 OLIMEXISPMK2 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Olimex AVR-ISP-MK2 Development Board. + * + * Board specific information header for the Olimex AVR-ISP-MK2 Development Board (https://www.olimex.com/dev/avr-isp-mk2.html). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_OLIMEXISPMK2_H__ +#define __BOARD_OLIMEXISPMK2_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXISPMK2/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXISPMK2/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3240dda075 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXISPMK2/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Olimex AVR-ISP-MK2 Development Board. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_OLIMEXISPMK2 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_OLIMEXISPMK2 OLIMEXISPMK2 + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Olimex AVR-ISP-MK2. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Olimex AVR-ISP-MK2 Development Board (https://www.olimex.com/dev/avr-isp-mk2.html). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_OLIMEXISPMK2_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_OLIMEXISPMK2_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 7) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PIND & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXISPMK2/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXISPMK2/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6bf924d36f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXISPMK2/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,143 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Olimex AVR-ISP-MK2 Development Board. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_OLIMEXISPMK2 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_OLIMEXISPMK2 OLIMEXISPMK2 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Olimex AVR-ISP-MK2. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Olimex AVR-ISP-MK2 Development Board (https://www.olimex.com/dev/avr-isp-mk2.html). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Yellow</td><td>Target Power</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Red</td><td>Activity</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.6</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Green</td><td>Ready</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_OLIMEXISPMK2_H__ +#define __LEDS_OLIMEXISPMK2_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 7) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRB |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTB &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRB &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTB &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINB = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (PORTB & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXT32U4/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXT32U4/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9b0b28cca2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXT32U4/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Olimex AVR-USB-T32U4 Development Board. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_OLIMEXT32U4 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_OLIMEXT32U4 OLIMEXT32U4 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Olimex AVR-USB-T32U4 Development Board. + * + * Board specific information header for the Olimex AVR-USB-T32U4 Development Board (http://www.olimex.com/dev/avr-t32u4.html). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_OLIMEXT32U4_H__ +#define __BOARD_OLIMEXT32U4_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXT32U4/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXT32U4/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5db1c59b28 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXT32U4/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Olimex AVR-USB-T32U4 Development Board. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_OLIMEXT32U4 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_OLIMEXT32U4 OLIMEXT32U4 + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Olimex AVR-USB-32U4 Development Board. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Olimex AVR-USB-T32U4 Development Board (http://www.olimex.com/dev/avr-t32u4.html). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTE.2</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_OLIMEXT32U4_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_OLIMEXT32U4_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 2) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTE |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PINE & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXT32U4/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXT32U4/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..96cf3ed692 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXT32U4/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,169 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Olimex AVR-USB-T32U4. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_OLIMEXT32U4 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_OLIMEXT32U4 OLIMEXT32U4 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Olimex AVR-USB-T32U4. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Olimex AVR-USB-T32U4 (http://www.olimex.com/dev/avr-t32u4.html). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Yellow</td><td>RX</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.0</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Green</td><td>TX</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>N/A</td><td>General Indicator (Not Mounted)</td><td>High</td><td>PORTE.6</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_OLIMEXT32U4_H__ +#define __LEDS_OLIMEXT32U4_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define LEDS_PORTB_LEDS (LEDS_LED1) + #define LEDS_PORTD_LEDS (LEDS_LED2) + #define LEDS_PORTE_LEDS (LEDS_LED3) + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 0) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRB |= LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + PORTB &= ~LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + DDRD |= LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + DDRE |= LEDS_PORTE_LEDS; + PORTE &= ~LEDS_PORTE_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRB &= ~LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + PORTB &= ~LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + DDRD &= ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + DDRE &= ~LEDS_PORTE_LEDS; + PORTE &= ~LEDS_PORTE_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTD |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PORTE |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTD &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PORTE &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB & ~LEDS_PORTB_LEDS) | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS)); + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS)); + PORTE = ((PORTE & ~LEDS_PORTE_LEDS) | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS)); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS)) | (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS)); + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS)) | (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS)); + PORTE = ((PORTE & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS)) | (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS)); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINB = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PIND = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PINE = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS); + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return ((PORTB & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS) | (PORTD & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) | (PORTE & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/POLOLUMICRO/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/POLOLUMICRO/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bf68e392cd --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/POLOLUMICRO/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,79 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the "Pololu A-Star Micro" board. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_POLOLUMICRO + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_POLOLUMICRO POLOLUMICRO + * \brief Board specific information header for the "Pololu A-Star Micro" board. + * + * Board specific information header: + * https://www.pololu.com/docs/0J61 -> https://www.pololu.com/docs/0J61/3.1 + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_POLOLUMICRO_H__ +#define __BOARD_POLOLUMICRO_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/POLOLUMICRO/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/POLOLUMICRO/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..454a9e2b01 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/POLOLUMICRO/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,154 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Pololu A-Star Micro board. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_MICRO + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_MICRO MICRO + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Pololu A-Star Micro board. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Pololu A-Star Micro board https://www.pololu.com/docs/0J61/3.1 + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Yellow</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTC.7</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Green</td><td>Bootloader, USB-activity</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.5</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_MICRO_H__ +#define __LEDS_MICRO_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define LEDS_PORTC_LEDS (LEDS_LED1) + #define LEDS_PORTD_LEDS (LEDS_LED2) + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 7) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRD |= LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + DDRC |= LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + PORTC &= ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + DDRC &= ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + PORTC &= ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PORTC |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PORTC &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS)); + PORTC = ((PORTC & ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS) | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS)); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS)) | (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS)); + PORTC = ((PORTC & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS)) | (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS)); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD ^= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PORTC ^= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS); + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return ((PORTD & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) | (PORTC & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/QMK/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/QMK/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..19a0f2dfee --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/QMK/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,65 @@ +/*
+Copyright 2017 Jack Humbert
+
+This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
+it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+the Free Software Foundation, either version 2 of the License, or
+(at your option) any later version.
+
+This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ * \brief General driver header for QMK-powered keyboards.
+ * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_QMK
+ *
+ * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver
+ * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h.
+ */
+
+/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo
+ * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_QMK QMK
+ * \brief General driver header for QMK-powered keyboards.
+ *
+ * General driver header for QMK-powered keyboards (http://qmk.fm).
+ *
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#ifndef __BOARD_QMK_H__
+#define __BOARD_QMK_H__
+
+ /* Includes: */
+ #include "../../../../Common/Common.h"
+ #include "../../LEDs.h"
+
+ /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */
+ #if defined(__cplusplus)
+ extern "C" {
+ #endif
+
+ /* Preprocessor Checks: */
+ #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H)
+ #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead.
+ #endif
+
+ /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */
+ /* Macros: */
+ /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */
+ #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS
+
+ /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */
+ #if defined(__cplusplus)
+ }
+ #endif
+
+#endif
+
+/** @} */
+
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/QMK/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/QMK/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1310612dc8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/QMK/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,194 @@ +/*
+Copyright 2017 Jack Humbert
+
+This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
+it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+the Free Software Foundation, either version 2 of the License, or
+(at your option) any later version.
+
+This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ * \brief General driver header for QMK-powered keyboards.
+ * \copydetails Group_LEDs_QMK
+ *
+ * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver
+ * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h.
+ */
+
+/** \ingroup Group_LEDs
+ * \defgroup Group_LEDs_QMK QMK
+ * \brief General driver header for QMK-powered keyboards.
+ *
+ * General driver header for QMK-powered keyboards (http://qmk.fm).
+ *
+ * <b>QMK</b>:
+ * <table>
+ * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr>
+ * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORT(QMK_LED).6</td></tr>
+ * </table>
+ *
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#ifndef __LEDS_QMK_H__
+#define __LEDS_QMK_H__
+
+ /* Includes: */
+ #include "../../../../Common/Common.h"
+
+ /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */
+ #if defined(__cplusplus)
+ extern "C" {
+ #endif
+
+ /* Preprocessor Checks: */
+ #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H)
+ #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead.
+ #endif
+
+ #define B0 0x30
+ #define B1 0x31
+ #define B2 0x32
+ #define B3 0x33
+ #define B4 0x34
+ #define B5 0x35
+ #define B6 0x36
+ #define B7 0x37
+ #define C0 0x60
+ #define C1 0x61
+ #define C2 0x62
+ #define C3 0x63
+ #define C4 0x64
+ #define C5 0x65
+ #define C6 0x66
+ #define C7 0x67
+ #define D0 0x90
+ #define D1 0x91
+ #define D2 0x92
+ #define D3 0x93
+ #define D4 0x94
+ #define D5 0x95
+ #define D6 0x96
+ #define D7 0x97
+ #define E0 0xC0
+ #define E1 0xC1
+ #define E2 0xC2
+ #define E3 0xC3
+ #define E4 0xC4
+ #define E5 0xC5
+ #define E6 0xC6
+ #define E7 0xC7
+ #define F0 0xF0
+ #define F1 0xF1
+ #define F2 0xF2
+ #define F3 0xF3
+ #define F4 0xF4
+ #define F5 0xF5
+ #define F6 0xF6
+ #define F7 0xF7
+ #define A0 0x00
+ #define A1 0x01
+ #define A2 0x02
+ #define A3 0x03
+ #define A4 0x04
+ #define A5 0x05
+ #define A6 0x06
+ #define A7 0x07
+
+ #define QMK_ESC_COL F1
+ #define QMK_ESC_ROW D5
+ #define QMK_LED E6
+ #define QMK_SPEAKER C6
+
+ #define DDR(pin) _SFR_IO8(((pin) >> 4) + 1)
+ #define PORT(pin) _SFR_IO8(((pin) >> 4) + 2)
+ #define PIN(pin) _SFR_IO8((pin) >> 4)
+ #define NUM(pin) _BV((pin) & 0xF)
+
+ /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */
+ /* Macros: */
+ /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */
+ #define LEDS_LED1 NUM(QMK_LED)
+ #define LEDS_LED2 NUM(QMK_SPEAKER)
+
+ /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */
+ #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2
+
+ /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */
+ #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0
+
+ /* Inline Functions: */
+ #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__)
+ static inline void LEDs_Init(void)
+ {
+ DDR(QMK_LED) |= LEDS_LED1;
+ PORT(QMK_LED) |= LEDS_LED1;
+
+ DDR(QMK_SPEAKER) |= LEDS_LED2;
+ PORT(QMK_SPEAKER) |= LEDS_LED2;
+ }
+
+ static inline void LEDs_Disable(void)
+ {
+ DDR(QMK_LED) &= ~LEDS_LED1;
+ PORT(QMK_LED) &= ~LEDS_LED2;
+
+ DDR(QMK_SPEAKER) &= ~LEDS_LED1;
+ PORT(QMK_SPEAKER) &= ~LEDS_LED2;
+ }
+
+ static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask)
+ {
+ PORT(QMK_LED) &= (LEDS_LED1 & ~LEDMask);
+ PORT(QMK_SPEAKER) &= (LEDS_LED2 & ~LEDMask);
+ }
+
+ static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask)
+ {
+ PORT(QMK_LED) |= (LEDS_LED1 & LEDMask);
+ PORT(QMK_SPEAKER) |= (LEDS_LED2 & LEDMask);
+ }
+
+ static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask)
+ {
+ PORT(QMK_LED) = ((PORT(QMK_LED) | LEDS_LED1) & ~LEDMask);
+ PORT(QMK_SPEAKER) = ((PORT(QMK_SPEAKER) | LEDS_LED2) & ~LEDMask);
+ }
+
+ static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask,
+ const uint8_t ActiveMask)
+ {
+ PORT(QMK_LED) = ((PORT(QMK_LED) | (LEDS_LED1 & LEDMask)) & ~ActiveMask);
+ PORT(QMK_SPEAKER) = ((PORT(QMK_SPEAKER) | (LEDS_LED1 & LEDMask)) & ~ActiveMask);
+ }
+
+ static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask)
+ {
+ PIN(QMK_LED) = (LEDS_LED1 & LEDMask);
+ PIN(QMK_SPEAKER) = (LEDS_LED2 & LEDMask);
+ }
+
+ static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT;
+ static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void)
+ {
+ return (~PORT(QMK_LED) & LEDS_LED1) | (~(PORT(QMK_SPEAKER) & LEDS_LED2));
+ }
+ #endif
+
+ /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */
+ #if defined(__cplusplus)
+ }
+ #endif
+
+#endif
+
+/** @} */
+
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/RZUSBSTICK/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/RZUSBSTICK/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..83219b9420 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/RZUSBSTICK/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel RZUSBSTICK. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_RZUSBSTICK + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_RZUSBSTICK RZUSBSTICK + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel RZUSBSTICK. + * + * Board specific information header for the Atmel RZUSBSTICK. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_RZUSBSTICK_H__ +#define __BOARD_RZUSBSTICK_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/RZUSBSTICK/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/RZUSBSTICK/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..25bdae1ae8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/RZUSBSTICK/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,175 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel RZUSBSTICK. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_RZUSBSTICK + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_RZUSBSTICK RZUSBSTICK + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel RZUSBSTICK. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel RZUSBSTICK. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Blue</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Red</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTE.6</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Yellow</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTE.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_RZUSBSTICK_H__ +#define __LEDS_RZUSBSTICK_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define LEDS_PORTD_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + #define LEDS_PORTE_LEDS (LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + + #define LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT 4 + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 7) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 ((1 << 6) >> LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT) + + /** LED mask for the fourth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED4 ((1 << 7) >> LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRD |= LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_LED1; + PORTD |= LEDS_LED2; + + DDRE |= (LEDS_PORTE_LEDS << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT); + PORTE |= (LEDS_PORTE_LEDS << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT); + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + + DDRE &= ~(LEDS_PORTE_LEDS << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT); + PORTE &= ~(LEDS_PORTE_LEDS << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT); + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD |= (LEDMask & LEDS_LED1); + PORTD &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_LED2); + PORTE &= ~((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT); + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_LED1); + PORTD |= (LEDMask & LEDS_LED2); + PORTE |= ((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT); + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD = (((PORTD & ~LEDS_LED1) | (LEDMask & LEDS_LED1)) | + ((PORTD | LEDS_LED2) & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_LED2))); + PORTE = ((PORTE | (LEDS_PORTE_LEDS << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT)) & + ~((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT)); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTD = (((PORTD & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_LED1)) | (ActiveMask & LEDS_LED1)) | + ((PORTD | (LEDMask & LEDS_LED2)) & ~(ActiveMask & LEDS_LED2))); + PORTE = ((PORTE | ((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT)) & + ~((ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT)); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PIND = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PINE = ((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT); + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (((PORTD & LEDS_LED1) | (~PORTD & LEDS_LED2)) | + ((~PORTE & (LEDS_PORTE_LEDS << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT)) >> LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/SPARKFUN8U2/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/SPARKFUN8U2/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7803ecdef4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/SPARKFUN8U2/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Sparkfun ATMEGA8U2 breakout board. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_SPARKFUN8U2 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_SPARKFUN8U2 SPARKFUN8U2 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Sparkfun ATMEGA8U2 breakout board. + * + * Board specific information header for the Sparkfun ATMEGA8U2 breakout board (http://www.sparkfun.com/products/10277). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_SPARKFUN8U2_H__ +#define __BOARD_SPARKFUN8U2_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/SPARKFUN8U2/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/SPARKFUN8U2/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..70ca608240 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/SPARKFUN8U2/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,135 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Sparkfun ATMEGA8U2 breakout board. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_SPARKFUN8U2 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_SPARKFUN8U2 SPARKFUN8U2 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Sparkfun ATMEGA8U2 breakout board. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Sparkfun ATMEGA8U2 breakout board (http://www.sparkfun.com/products/10277). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTB.4</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_SPARKFUN8U2_H__ +#define __LEDS_SPARKFUN8U2_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 4) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRB |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTB |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRB &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTB &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB | LEDS_ALL_LEDS) & ~LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB | LEDMask) & ~ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINB = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (~PORTB & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STANGE_ISP/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STANGE_ISP/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..45472f139f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STANGE_ISP/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Dimex Stange-ISP board. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_STANGE_ISP + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_STANGE_ISP STANGE_ISP + * \brief Board specific information header for the Dimex Stange-ISP board. + * + * Board specific information header for the Dimex Stange-ISP board (http://www.diamex.de/dxshop/USB-ISP-Programmer-fuer-Atmel-AVR). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_STANGE_ISP_H__ +#define __BOARD_STANGE_ISP_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STANGE_ISP/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STANGE_ISP/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2607622bd1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STANGE_ISP/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific button driver header for the Dimex Stange-ISP board. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_STANGE_ISP + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_STANGE_ISP STANGE_ISP + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Dimex Stange-ISP. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Dimex Stange-ISP board (http://www.diamex.de/dxshop/USB-ISP-Programmer-fuer-Atmel-AVR). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_STANGE_ISP_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_STANGE_ISP_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 7) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PIND & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STANGE_ISP/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STANGE_ISP/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..97a7e37220 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STANGE_ISP/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,138 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Dimex Stange-ISP board. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_STANGE_ISP + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_STANGE_ISP STANGE_ISP + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Dimex Stange-ISP board. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Dimex Stange-ISP board (http://www.diamex.de/dxshop/USB-ISP-Programmer-fuer-Atmel-AVR). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.0</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Red</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.1</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_STANGE_ISP_LEDS_H__ +#define __LEDS_STANGE_ISP_LEDS_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 0) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 1) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs (const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD | LEDS_ALL_LEDS) & ~LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs ( const uint8_t LEDMask, const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD | LEDMask) & ~ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PIND = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (~PORTD & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a6831a7bbd --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,90 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel STK525. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_STK525 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_STK525 STK525 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel STK525. + * + * Board specific information header for the Atmel STK525. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_STK525_H__ +#define __BOARD_STK525_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../Dataflash.h" + #include "../../Joystick.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Dataflash mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_DATAFLASH + + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Joystick mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_JOYSTICK + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5770d070d0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel STK525. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_STK525 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_STK525 STK525 + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel STK525. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel STK525. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTE.2</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_STK525_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_STK525_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 2) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTE |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PINE & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/Dataflash.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/Dataflash.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b0b2855f6c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/Dataflash.h @@ -0,0 +1,222 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Dataflash driver header for the Atmel STK525. + * \copydetails Group_Dataflash_STK525 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the dataflash driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Dataflash + * \defgroup Group_Dataflash_STK525 STK525 + * \brief Board specific Dataflash driver header for the Atmel STK525. + * + * Board specific Dataflash driver header for the Atmel STK525. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Select Pin</th><th>SPI Port</th></tr> + * <tr><td>DATAFLASH_CHIP1</td><td>AT45DB321C (4MB)</td><td>PORTB.4</td><td>SPI0</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __DATAFLASH_STK525_H__ +#define __DATAFLASH_STK525_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../../Misc/AT45DB321C.h" + #include "../../../Peripheral/SPI.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_DATAFLASH_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK DATAFLASH_CHIP1 + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_DDR DDRB + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT PORTB + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Constant indicating the total number of dataflash ICs mounted on the selected board. */ + #define DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS 1 + + /** Mask for no dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP 0 + + /** Mask for the first dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIP1 (1 << 4) + + /** Internal main memory page size for the board's dataflash IC. */ + #define DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE 512 + + /** Total number of pages inside the board's dataflash IC. */ + #define DATAFLASH_PAGES 8192 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initializes the dataflash driver so that commands and data may be sent to an attached dataflash IC. + * The appropriate SPI interface will be automatically configured. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_Init(void) + { + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_DDR |= DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK; + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT |= DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK; + + SPI_Init(SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_2 | SPI_ORDER_MSB_FIRST | SPI_SCK_LEAD_FALLING | SPI_SAMPLE_TRAILING | SPI_MODE_MASTER); + } + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns a byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + return SPI_TransferByte(Byte); + } + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and ignores the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + SPI_SendByte(Byte); + } + + /** Sends a dummy byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) + { + return SPI_ReceiveByte(); + } + + /** Determines the currently selected dataflash chip. + * + * \return Mask of the currently selected Dataflash chip, either \ref DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP if no chip is selected + * or a DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is the chip number). + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) + { + return (~DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT & DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK); + } + + /** Selects the given dataflash chip. + * + * \param[in] ChipMask Mask of the Dataflash IC to select, in the form of a \c DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is + * the chip number). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) + { + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT = ((DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT | DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK) & ~ChipMask); + } + + /** Deselects the current dataflash chip, so that no dataflash is selected. */ + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) + { + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP); + } + + /** Selects a dataflash IC from the given page number, which should range from 0 to + * ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). For boards containing only one + * dataflash IC, this will select DATAFLASH_CHIP1. If the given page number is outside + * the total number of pages contained in the boards dataflash ICs, all dataflash ICs + * are deselected. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Address of the page to manipulate, ranging from + * 0 to ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(const uint16_t PageAddress) + { + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + if (PageAddress >= DATAFLASH_PAGES) + return; + + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + } + + /** Toggles the select line of the currently selected dataflash IC, so that it is ready to receive + * a new command. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(void) + { + uint8_t SelectedChipMask = Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(); + + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + Dataflash_SelectChip(SelectedChipMask); + } + + /** Spin-loops while the currently selected dataflash is busy executing a command, such as a main + * memory page program or main memory to buffer transfer. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(void) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + while (!(Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_READY)); + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + } + + /** Sends a set of page and buffer address bytes to the currently selected dataflash IC, for use with + * dataflash commands which require a complete 24-bit address. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Page address within the selected dataflash IC + * \param[in] BufferByte Address within the dataflash's buffer + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(uint16_t PageAddress, + const uint16_t BufferByte) + { + Dataflash_SendByte(PageAddress >> 6); + Dataflash_SendByte((PageAddress << 2) | (BufferByte >> 8)); + Dataflash_SendByte(BufferByte); + } + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/Joystick.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/Joystick.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0224a723e7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/Joystick.h @@ -0,0 +1,130 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific joystick driver header for the Atmel STK525. + * \copydetails Group_Joystick_STK525 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the joystick driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Joystick + * \defgroup Group_Joystick_STK525 STK525 + * \brief Board specific joystick driver header for the Atmel STK525. + * + * Board specific joystick driver header for the Atmel STK525. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Left Port Pin</th><th>Up Port Pin</th><th>Right Port Pin</th><th>Down Port Pin</th><th>Press Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>PORTB.6</td><td>PORTB.7</td><td>PORTE.4</td><td>PORTE.5</td><td>PORTB.5</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __JOYSTICK_STK525_H__ +#define __JOYSTICK_STK525_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_JOYSTICK_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define JOY_BMASK ((1 << 5) | (1 << 6) | (1 << 7)) + #define JOY_EMASK ((1 << 4) | (1 << 5)) + + #define JOY_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT 1 + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the left direction. */ + #define JOY_LEFT (1 << 6) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the right direction. */ + #define JOY_RIGHT ((1 << 4) >> JOY_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the upward direction. */ + #define JOY_UP (1 << 7) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the downward direction. */ + #define JOY_DOWN ((1 << 5) >> JOY_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed inward. */ + #define JOY_PRESS (1 << 5) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Joystick_Init(void) + { + DDRB &= ~JOY_BMASK; + DDRE &= ~JOY_EMASK; + + PORTB |= JOY_BMASK; + PORTE |= JOY_EMASK; + } + + static inline void Joystick_Disable(void) + { + DDRB &= ~JOY_BMASK; + DDRE &= ~JOY_EMASK; + + PORTB &= ~JOY_BMASK; + PORTE &= ~JOY_EMASK; + } + + static inline uint8_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) + { + return (((uint8_t)~PINB & JOY_BMASK) | (((uint8_t)~PINE & JOY_EMASK) >> JOY_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e4138166d2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,147 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel STK525. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_STK525 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_STK525 STK525 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel STK525. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel STK525. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.4</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.6</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED4</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_STK525_H__ +#define __LEDS_STK525_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 4) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 7) + + /** LED mask for the fourth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED4 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PIND = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (PORTD & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1c4ee85c15 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,90 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel STK526. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_STK526 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_STK526 STK526 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel STK526. + * + * Board specific information header for the Atmel STK526. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_STK526_H__ +#define __BOARD_STK526_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../Dataflash.h" + #include "../../Joystick.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Dataflash mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_DATAFLASH + + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Joystick mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_JOYSTICK + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..168adaa9bf --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel STK526. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_STK526 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_STK526 STK526 + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel STK526. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel STK526. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_STK526_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_STK526_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 7) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PIND & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/Dataflash.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/Dataflash.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..82b311bbc2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/Dataflash.h @@ -0,0 +1,222 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Dataflash driver header for the Atmel STK525. + * \copydetails Group_Dataflash_STK526 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the dataflash driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Dataflash + * \defgroup Group_Dataflash_STK526 STK526 + * \brief Board specific Dataflash driver header for the Atmel STK525. + * + * Board specific Dataflash driver header for the Atmel STK525. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Select Pin</th><th>SPI Port</th></tr> + * <tr><td>DATAFLASH_CHIP1</td><td>AT45DB642D (8MB)</td><td>PORTC.2</td><td>SPI0</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __DATAFLASH_STK526_H__ +#define __DATAFLASH_STK526_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../../Misc/AT45DB642D.h" + #include "../../../Peripheral/SPI.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_DATAFLASH_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK DATAFLASH_CHIP1 + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_DDR DDRC + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT PORTC + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Constant indicating the total number of dataflash ICs mounted on the selected board. */ + #define DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS 1 + + /** Mask for no dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP 0 + + /** Mask for the first dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIP1 (1 << 2) + + /** Internal main memory page size for the board's dataflash IC. */ + #define DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE 1024 + + /** Total number of pages inside the board's dataflash IC. */ + #define DATAFLASH_PAGES 8192 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initializes the dataflash driver so that commands and data may be sent to an attached dataflash IC. + * The appropriate SPI interface will be automatically configured. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_Init(void) + { + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_DDR |= DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK; + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT |= DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK; + + SPI_Init(SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_2 | SPI_ORDER_MSB_FIRST | SPI_SCK_LEAD_FALLING | SPI_SAMPLE_TRAILING | SPI_MODE_MASTER); + } + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns a byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + return SPI_TransferByte(Byte); + } + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and ignores the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + SPI_SendByte(Byte); + } + + /** Sends a dummy byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) + { + return SPI_ReceiveByte(); + } + + /** Determines the currently selected dataflash chip. + * + * \return Mask of the currently selected Dataflash chip, either \ref DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP if no chip is selected + * or a DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is the chip number). + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) + { + return (~DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT & DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK); + } + + /** Selects the given dataflash chip. + * + * \param[in] ChipMask Mask of the Dataflash IC to select, in the form of a \c DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is + * the chip number). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) + { + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT = ((DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT | DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK) & ~ChipMask); + } + + /** Deselects the current dataflash chip, so that no dataflash is selected. */ + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) + { + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP); + } + + /** Selects a dataflash IC from the given page number, which should range from 0 to + * ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). For boards containing only one + * dataflash IC, this will select DATAFLASH_CHIP1. If the given page number is outside + * the total number of pages contained in the boards dataflash ICs, all dataflash ICs + * are deselected. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Address of the page to manipulate, ranging from + * 0 to ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(const uint16_t PageAddress) + { + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + if (PageAddress >= DATAFLASH_PAGES) + return; + + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + } + + /** Toggles the select line of the currently selected dataflash IC, so that it is ready to receive + * a new command. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(void) + { + uint8_t SelectedChipMask = Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(); + + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + Dataflash_SelectChip(SelectedChipMask); + } + + /** Spin-loops while the currently selected dataflash is busy executing a command, such as a main + * memory page program or main memory to buffer transfer. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(void) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + while (!(Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_READY)); + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + } + + /** Sends a set of page and buffer address bytes to the currently selected dataflash IC, for use with + * dataflash commands which require a complete 24-bit address. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Page address within the selected dataflash IC + * \param[in] BufferByte Address within the dataflash's buffer + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(uint16_t PageAddress, + const uint16_t BufferByte) + { + Dataflash_SendByte(PageAddress >> 5); + Dataflash_SendByte((PageAddress << 3) | (BufferByte >> 8)); + Dataflash_SendByte(BufferByte); + } + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/Joystick.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/Joystick.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c7d816c83d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/Joystick.h @@ -0,0 +1,123 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific joystick driver header for the Atmel STK526. + * \copydetails Group_Joystick_STK526 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the joystick driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Joystick + * \defgroup Group_Joystick_STK526 STK526 + * \brief Board specific joystick driver header for the Atmel STK526. + * + * Board specific joystick driver header for the Atmel STK526. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Left Port Pin</th><th>Up Port Pin</th><th>Right Port Pin</th><th>Down Port Pin</th><th>Press Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>PORTB.4</td><td>PORTB.5</td><td>PORTB.6</td><td>PORTB.7</td><td>PORTB.0</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __JOYSTICK_STK526_H__ +#define __JOYSTICK_STK526_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_JOYSTICK_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define JOY_BMASK ((1 << 0) | (1 << 4) | (1 << 5) | (1 << 6) | (1 << 7)) + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the left direction. */ + #define JOY_LEFT (1 << 4) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the right direction. */ + #define JOY_RIGHT (1 << 6) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the upward direction. */ + #define JOY_UP (1 << 5) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the downward direction. */ + #define JOY_DOWN (1 << 7) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed inward. */ + #define JOY_PRESS (1 << 0) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Joystick_Init(void) + { + DDRB &= ~JOY_BMASK; + + PORTB |= JOY_BMASK; + } + + static inline void Joystick_Disable(void) + { + DDRB &= ~JOY_BMASK; + + PORTB &= ~JOY_BMASK; + } + + static inline uint8_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((uint8_t)~PINB & JOY_BMASK); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fc561e7336 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,147 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel STK526. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_STK526 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_STK526 STK526 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel STK526. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel STK526. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.1</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.0</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED4</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.4</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_STK526_H__ +#define __LEDS_STK526_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 1) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 0) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for the fourth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED4 (1 << 4) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PIND = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (PORTD & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/TEENSY/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/TEENSY/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..15237b625a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/TEENSY/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,85 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the PJRC Teensy 1.x/2.x boards. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_TEENSY + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_TEENSY2 TEENSY2 + * \brief Board specific information header for the PJRC Teensy 2 boards. + * + * See \ref Group_BoardInfo_TEENSY for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_TEENSY TEENSY + * \brief Board specific information header for the PJRC Teensy 1.x/2.x boards. + * + * Board specific information header for the PJRC Teensy boards (http://www.pjrc.com/teensy/index.html). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_TEENSY_H__ +#define __BOARD_TEENSY_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/TEENSY/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/TEENSY/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ed7fbf0946 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/TEENSY/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,176 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the PJRC Teensy 1.x/2.x boards. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_TEENSY + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_TEENSY2 TEENSY2 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the PJRC Teensy 2 boards. + * + * See \ref Group_LEDs_TEENSY for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_TEENSY TEENSY + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the PJRC Teensy 1.x/2.x boards. + * + * \note For version 2 Teensy boards, compile with <code>BOARD = TEENSY2</code>. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the PJRC Teensy boards (http://www.pjrc.com/teensy/index.html). + * + * <b>TEENSY</b>: + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.6</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * <b>TEENSY2</b>: + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.6</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_TEENSY_H__ +#define __LEDS_TEENSY_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + + #if (BOARD == BOARD_TEENSY2) + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + #else + PORTD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + #endif + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + #if (BOARD == BOARD_TEENSY2) + PORTD |= LEDMask; + #else + PORTD &= ~LEDMask; + #endif + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + #if (BOARD == BOARD_TEENSY2) + PORTD &= ~LEDMask; + #else + PORTD |= LEDMask; + #endif + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + #if (BOARD == BOARD_TEENSY2) + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LEDMask); + #else + PORTD = ((PORTD | LEDS_ALL_LEDS) & ~LEDMask); + #endif + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + #if (BOARD == BOARD_TEENSY2) + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask); + #else + PORTD = ((PORTD | LEDMask) & ~ActiveMask); + #endif + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PIND = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + #if (BOARD == BOARD_TEENSY2) + return (PORTD & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + #else + return (~PORTD & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + #endif + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/TUL/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/TUL/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..066e6c3ed7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/TUL/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the TUL. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_TUL + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_TUL TUL + * \brief Board specific information header for the TUL. + * + * Board specific information header for the Busware TUL (http://www.busware.de/tiki-index.php?page=TUL). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_TUL_H__ +#define __BOARD_TUL_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/TUL/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/TUL/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..af6b2ae611 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/TUL/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the TUL. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_TUL + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_TUL TUL + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the TUL. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Busware TUL (http://www.busware.de/tiki-index.php?page=TUL). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTE.2</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_TUL_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_TUL_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 2) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTE |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PINE & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/TUL/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/TUL/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9417b67638 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/TUL/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,135 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Busware TUL. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_TUL + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_TUL TUL + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Busware TUL. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Busware TUL (http://www.busware.de/tiki-index.php?page=TUL). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTF.0</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_TUL_H__ +#define __LEDS_TUL_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 0) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRF |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTF &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRF &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTF &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTF |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTF &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTF = ((PORTF & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTF = ((PORTF & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINF = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (PORTF & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/U2S/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/U2S/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6ea238028c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/U2S/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the U2S. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_U2S + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_U2S U2S + * \brief Board specific information header for the U2S. + * + * Board specific information header for the U2S (http://sites.google.com/site/megau2s/). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_U2S__ +#define __BOARD_U2S__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has a hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/U2S/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/U2S/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ea5c1af4fd --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/U2S/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the U2S. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_U2S + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_U2S U2S + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the U2S. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the U2S (http://sites.google.com/site/megau2s/). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTC.4</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_U2S__ +#define __BUTTONS_U2S__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 4) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRC &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTC |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRC &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTC &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PINC & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/U2S/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/U2S/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..942fdc0e6c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/U2S/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,135 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the U2S. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_U2S + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_U2S U2S + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the U2S. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the U2S (http://sites.google.com/site/megau2s/). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Red</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTC.2</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_U2S__ +#define __LEDS_U2S__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 2) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRC |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTC |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRC &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTC &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTC &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTC |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTC = ((PORTC | LEDS_ALL_LEDS) & ~LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTC = ((PORTC | LEDMask) & ~ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINC = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (~PORTC & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/UDIP/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/UDIP/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c8b6e77656 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/UDIP/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the UDIP. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_UDIP + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_UDIP UDIP + * \brief Board specific information header for the UDIP. + * + * Board specific information header for the Linnix UDIP (http://linnix.com/udip/). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_UDIP_H__ +#define __BOARD_UDIP_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/UDIP/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/UDIP/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f579b29b75 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/UDIP/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the UDIP. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_UDIP + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_UDIP UDIP + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the UDIP. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Linnix UDIP (http://linnix.com/udip/). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_UDIP_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_UDIP_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 7) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PIND & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/UDIP/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/UDIP/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1bf839823a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/UDIP/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,163 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Linnix UDIP. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_UDIP + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_UDIP UDIP + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Linnix UDIP. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Linnix UDIP (http://linnix.com/udip/). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>Bicolor Indicator 1</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.6</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Red</td><td>Bicolor Indicator 1</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Green</td><td>Bicolor Indicator 2</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED4</td><td>Red</td><td>Bicolor Indicator 2</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.4</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_UDIP_H__ +#define __LEDS_UDIP_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define LEDS_PORTB_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + #define LEDS_PORTD_LEDS (LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + + #define LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT 1 + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 ((1 << 5) >> LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT) + + /** LED mask for the fourth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED4 ((1 << 4) >> LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRB |= LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + DDRD |= (LEDS_PORTD_LEDS << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT); + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRB &= ~LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + DDRD &= ~(LEDS_PORTD_LEDS << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT); + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTD |= ((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT); + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTD &= ~((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT); + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB = (PORTB & ~LEDS_PORTB_LEDS) | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTD = (PORTD & ~(LEDS_PORTD_LEDS << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT)) | + ((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTB = (PORTB & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS)) | (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTD = (PORTD & ~((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT)) | + ((ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINB = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PIND = ((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT); + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return ((PORTB & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS) | ((PORTD & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) >> LEDS_PORTD_MASK_SHIFT)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/UNO/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/UNO/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9277a3824c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/UNO/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,84 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Arduino Uno. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_UNO + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_UNO UNO + * \brief Board specific information header for the Arduino Uno. + * + * Board specific information header for the Arduino Uno (http://arduino.cc/en/Main/ArduinoBoardUno). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_UNO_H__ +#define __BOARD_UNO_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /** Pin that can reset the main MCU. */ + #define AVR_RESET_LINE_PORT PORTD + #define AVR_RESET_LINE_DDR DDRD + #define AVR_RESET_LINE_PIN PIND + #define AVR_RESET_LINE_MASK (1 << PD7) + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/UNO/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/UNO/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..17526f3c56 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/UNO/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,145 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Arduino Uno. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_UNO + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_UNO UNO + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Arduino Uno. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Arduino Uno (http://arduino.cc/en/Main/ArduinoBoardUno). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Yellow</td><td>RX</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Yellow</td><td>TX</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.4</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_UNO_H__ +#define __LEDS_UNO_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 4) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate TX activity. */ + #define LEDMASK_TX LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate RX activity. */ + #define LEDMASK_RX LEDS_LED2 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD | LEDS_ALL_LEDS) & ~LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD | LEDMask) & ~ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PIND = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (~PORTD & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USB2AX/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USB2AX/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c6fcd43ff5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USB2AX/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,105 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Xevelabs USB2AX. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_USB2AX + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_USB2AX_V31 USB2AX_V31 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Xevelabs USB2AX revision 3.1. + * + * See \ref Group_BoardInfo_USB2AX for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_USB2AX_V3 USB2AX_V3 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Xevelabs USB2AX revision 3. + * + * See \ref Group_BoardInfo_USB2AX for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_USB2AX USB2AX + * \brief Board specific information header for the Xevelabs USB2AX. + * + * Board specific information header for the Xevelabs USB2AX (http://paranoidstudio.assembla.com/wiki/show/paranoidstudio/USB2AX). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_USB2AX_H__ +#define __BOARD_USB2AX_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + #if (BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX) || (BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX_V3) || \ + defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #include "../../Buttons.h" + + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + #endif + + #if ((BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX) || (BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX_V3) || \ + (BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX_V31) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USB2AX/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USB2AX/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..df6ef64ba3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USB2AX/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,120 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Xevelabs USB2AX. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_USB2AX + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_USB2AX_V31 USB2AX_V31 + * \brief Board specific Button driver header for the Xevelabs USB2AX revision 3.1. + * + * See \ref Group_Buttons_USB2AX for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_USB2AX_V3 USB2AX_V3 + * \brief Board specific Button driver header for the Xevelabs USB2AX revision 3. + * + * See \ref Group_Buttons_USB2AX for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_USB2AX USB2AX + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Xevelabs USB2AX revisions 1 and 2. + * + * \note For version 3 USB2AX boards, compile with <code>BOARD = USB2AX_V3</code> and for version 3.1, with <code>BOARD = USB2AX_V31</code>. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Paranoid Studio USB2AX (http://paranoidstudio.assembla.com/wiki/show/paranoidstudio/USB2AX). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_USB2AX_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_USB2AX_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 7) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PIND & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USB2AX/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USB2AX/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b4ed1ca09c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USB2AX/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,218 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Xevelabs USB2AX. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_USB2AX + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_USB2AX_V31 USB2AX_V31 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Xevelabs USB2AX revision 3.1. + * + * See \ref Group_LEDs_USB2AX for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_USB2AX_V3 USB2AX_V3 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Xevelabs USB2AX revision 3. + * + * See \ref Group_LEDs_USB2AX for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_USB2AX USB2AX + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Xevelabs USB2AX revisions 1 and 2. + * + * \note For version 3 USB2AX boards, compile with <code>BOARD = USB2AX_V3</code> and for version 3.1, with <code>BOARD = USB2AX_V31</code>. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Xevelabs USB2AX (http://paranoidstudio.assembla.com/wiki/show/paranoidstudio/USB2AX). + * + * <b>USB2AX</b>: + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTC.6</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * <b>USB2AX_V3</b>: + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.1</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * <b>USB2AX_V31</b>: + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Red</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.6</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_USB2AX_H__ +#define __LEDS_USB2AX_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #if (BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX_V31) + #define USB2AX_LEDS_LED1 (1 << 5) + #define USB2AX_LEDS_LED2 (1 << 6) + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX_V3) + #define USB2AX_LEDS_LED1 (1 << 1) + #define USB2AX_LEDS_LED2 0 + #else + #define USB2AX_LEDS_LED1 (1 << 6) + #define USB2AX_LEDS_LED2 0 + #endif + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 USB2AX_LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 USB2AX_LEDS_LED2 + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + #if (BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX) + DDRC |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTC &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + #else + DDRD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + #endif + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + #if (BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX) + DDRC &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTC &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + #else + DDRD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + #endif + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + #if (BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX) + PORTC |= LEDMask; + #else + PORTD |= LEDMask; + #endif + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + #if (BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX) + PORTC &= ~LEDMask; + #else + PORTD &= ~LEDMask; + #endif + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + #if (BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX) + PORTC = ((PORTC & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LEDMask); + #else + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LEDMask); + #endif + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + #if (BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX) + PORTC = ((PORTC & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask); + #else + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask); + #endif + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + #if (BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX) + PINC = LEDMask; + #else + PIND = LEDMask; + #endif + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + #if (BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX) + return (PORTC & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + #else + return (PORTD & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + #endif + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBFOO/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBFOO/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fa01b5bab0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBFOO/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Kernel Concepts USBFOO. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_USBFOO + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_USBFOO USBFOO + * \brief Board specific information header for the Kernel Concepts USBFOO. + * + * Board specific information header for the Kernel Concepts USBFOO (http://shop.kernelconcepts.de/product_info.php?products_id=102). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_USBFOO_H__ +#define __BOARD_USBFOO_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBFOO/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBFOO/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9c2476cc29 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBFOO/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Kernel Concepts USBFOO. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_USBFOO + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_USBFOO USBFOO + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Kernel Concepts USBFOO. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Kernel Concepts USBFOO (http://shop.kernelconcepts.de/product_info.php?products_id=102). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_USBFOO_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_USBFOO_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 7) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PIND & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBFOO/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBFOO/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9c5b8bc353 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBFOO/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,135 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Kernel Concepts USBFOO. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_USBFOO + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_USBFOO USBFOO + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Kernel Concepts USBFOO. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Kernel Concepts USBFOO (http://shop.kernelconcepts.de/product_info.php?products_id=102). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.4</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_USBFOO_H__ +#define __LEDS_USBFOO_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 4) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD | LEDS_ALL_LEDS) & ~LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD | LEDMask) & ~ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PIND = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (~PORTD & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..920681d036 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,90 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel USBKEY. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_USBKEY + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_USBKEY USBKEY + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel USBKEY. + * + * Board specific information header for the Atmel USBKEY. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_USBKEY_H__ +#define __BOARD_USBKEY_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../Dataflash.h" + #include "../../Joystick.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Dataflash mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_DATAFLASH + + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Joystick mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_JOYSTICK + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..068fd0b723 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel USBKEY. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_USBKEY + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_USBKEY USBKEY + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel USBKEY. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel USBKEY. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTE.2</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_USBKEY_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_USBKEY_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 2) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTE |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTE &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PINE & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/Dataflash.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/Dataflash.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..77be220118 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/Dataflash.h @@ -0,0 +1,237 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Dataflash driver header for the Atmel USBKEY. + * \copydetails Group_Dataflash_USBKEY + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the dataflash driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Dataflash + * \defgroup Group_Dataflash_USBKEY USBKEY + * \brief Board specific Dataflash driver header for the Atmel USBKEY. + * + * Board specific Dataflash driver header for the Atmel USBKEY board. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Select Pin</th><th>SPI Port</th></tr> + * <tr><td>DATAFLASH_CHIP1</td><td>AT45DB642D (8MB)</td><td>PORTE.0</td><td>SPI0</td></tr> + * <tr><td>DATAFLASH_CHIP2</td><td>AT45DB642D (8MB)</td><td>PORTE.1</td><td>SPI0</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __DATAFLASH_USBKEY_H__ +#define __DATAFLASH_USBKEY_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../../Misc/AT45DB642D.h" + #include "../../../Peripheral/SPI.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_DATAFLASH_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK (DATAFLASH_CHIP1 | DATAFLASH_CHIP2) + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_DDR DDRE + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT PORTE + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Constant indicating the total number of dataflash ICs mounted on the selected board. */ + #define DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS 2 + + /** Mask for no dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP 0 + + /** Mask for the first dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIP1 (1 << 0) + + /** Mask for the second dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIP2 (1 << 1) + + /** Internal main memory page size for the board's dataflash ICs. */ + #define DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE 1024 + + /** Total number of pages inside each of the board's dataflash ICs. */ + #define DATAFLASH_PAGES 8192 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initializes the dataflash driver so that commands and data may be sent to an attached dataflash IC. + * The appropriate SPI interface will be automatically configured. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_Init(void) + { + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_DDR |= DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK; + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT |= DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK; + + SPI_Init(SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_2 | SPI_ORDER_MSB_FIRST | SPI_SCK_LEAD_FALLING | SPI_SAMPLE_TRAILING | SPI_MODE_MASTER); + } + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns a byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + return SPI_TransferByte(Byte); + } + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and ignores the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + SPI_SendByte(Byte); + } + + /** Sends a dummy byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) + { + return SPI_ReceiveByte(); + } + + /** Determines the currently selected dataflash chip. + * + * \return Mask of the currently selected Dataflash chip, either \ref DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP if no chip is selected + * or a DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is the chip number). + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) + { + return (~DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT & DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK); + } + + /** Selects the given dataflash chip. + * + * \param[in] ChipMask Mask of the Dataflash IC to select, in the form of a \c DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is + * the chip number). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) + { + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT = ((DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT | DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK) & ~ChipMask); + } + + /** Deselects the current dataflash chip, so that no dataflash is selected. */ + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) + { + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP); + } + + /** Selects a dataflash IC from the given page number, which should range from 0 to + * ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). For boards containing only one + * dataflash IC, this will select DATAFLASH_CHIP1. If the given page number is outside + * the total number of pages contained in the boards dataflash ICs, all dataflash ICs + * are deselected. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Address of the page to manipulate, ranging from + * 0 to ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(const uint16_t PageAddress) + { + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + if (PageAddress >= (DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS)) + return; + + #if (DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS == 2) + if (PageAddress & 0x01) + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP2); + else + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + #else + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + #endif + } + + /** Toggles the select line of the currently selected dataflash IC, so that it is ready to receive + * a new command. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(void) + { + uint8_t SelectedChipMask = Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(); + + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + Dataflash_SelectChip(SelectedChipMask); + } + + /** Spin-loops while the currently selected dataflash is busy executing a command, such as a main + * memory page program or main memory to buffer transfer. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(void) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + while (!(Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_READY)); + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + } + + /** Sends a set of page and buffer address bytes to the currently selected dataflash IC, for use with + * dataflash commands which require a complete 24-bit address. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Page address within the selected dataflash IC + * \param[in] BufferByte Address within the dataflash's buffer + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(uint16_t PageAddress, + const uint16_t BufferByte) + { + #if (DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS == 2) + PageAddress >>= 1; + #endif + + Dataflash_SendByte(PageAddress >> 5); + Dataflash_SendByte((PageAddress << 3) | (BufferByte >> 8)); + Dataflash_SendByte(BufferByte); + } + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/Joystick.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/Joystick.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7410364445 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/Joystick.h @@ -0,0 +1,130 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific joystick driver header for the Atmel USBKEY. + * \copydetails Group_Joystick_USBKEY + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the joystick driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Joystick + * \defgroup Group_Joystick_USBKEY USBKEY + * \brief Board specific joystick driver header for the Atmel USBKEY. + * + * Board specific joystick driver header for the Atmel USBKEY. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Left Port Pin</th><th>Up Port Pin</th><th>Right Port Pin</th><th>Down Port Pin</th><th>Press Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>PORTB.6</td><td>PORTB.7</td><td>PORTE.4</td><td>PORTE.5</td><td>PORTB.5</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __JOYSTICK_USBKEY_H__ +#define __JOYSTICK_USBKEY_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_JOYSTICK_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define JOY_BMASK ((1 << 5) | (1 << 6) | (1 << 7)) + #define JOY_EMASK ((1 << 4) | (1 << 5)) + + #define JOY_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT 1 + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the left direction. */ + #define JOY_LEFT (1 << 6) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the right direction. */ + #define JOY_RIGHT ((1 << 4) >> JOY_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the upward direction. */ + #define JOY_UP (1 << 7) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the downward direction. */ + #define JOY_DOWN ((1 << 5) >> JOY_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed inward. */ + #define JOY_PRESS (1 << 5) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Joystick_Init(void) + { + DDRB &= ~JOY_BMASK; + DDRE &= ~JOY_EMASK; + + PORTB |= JOY_BMASK; + PORTE |= JOY_EMASK; + } + + static inline void Joystick_Disable(void) + { + DDRB &= ~JOY_BMASK; + DDRE &= ~JOY_EMASK; + + PORTB &= ~JOY_BMASK; + PORTE &= ~JOY_EMASK; + } + + static inline uint8_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) + { + return (((uint8_t)~PINB & JOY_BMASK) | (((uint8_t)~PINE & JOY_EMASK) >> JOY_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..18ff756c8a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,147 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel USBKEY. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_USBKEY + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_USBKEY USBKEY + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel USBKEY. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel USBKEY. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Red</td><td>Bicolor Indicator 1</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.4</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Green</td><td>Bicolor Indicator 1</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Red</td><td>Bicolor Indicator 2</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.6</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED4</td><td>Green</td><td>Bicolor Indicator 2</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_USBKEY_H__ +#define __LEDS_USBKEY_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 4) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 7) + + /** LED mask for the fourth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED4 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRD |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTD = ((PORTD & ~LEDMask) | ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PIND = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (PORTD & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBTINYMKII/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBTINYMKII/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5501bf6be7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBTINYMKII/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for Tom's USBTINY MKII. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_USBTINYMKII + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_USBTINYMKII USBTINYMKII + * \brief Board specific information header for Tom's USBTINY MKII. + * + * Board specific information header for Tom's USBTINY MKII (http://tom-itx.dyndns.org:81/~webpage/). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_USBTINYMKII_H__ +#define __BOARD_USBTINYMKII_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBTINYMKII/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBTINYMKII/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e87f611d5c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBTINYMKII/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for Tom's USBTINY MKII. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_USBTINYMKII + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_USBTINYMKII USBTINYMKII + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for Tom's USBTINY MKII. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for Tom's USBTINY MKII (http://tom-itx.dyndns.org:81/~webpage/). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>HWB Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_USBTINYMKII_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_USBTINYMKII_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 7) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD |= BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + DDRD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTD &= ~BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PIND & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ^ BUTTONS_BUTTON1); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBTINYMKII/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBTINYMKII/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..288f5505fa --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBTINYMKII/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,143 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for Tom's USBTINY MKII. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_USBTINYMKII + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_USBTINYMKII USBTINYMKII + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for Tom's USBTINY MKII. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for Tom's USBTINY MKII (http://tom-itx.dyndns.org:81/~webpage/). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Red</td><td>Bicolor Indicator 1</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.6</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Green</td><td>Bicolor Indicator 1</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.7</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Red</td><td>Target Power</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.5</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_USBTINYMKII_H__ +#define __LEDS_USBTINYMKII_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 7) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRB |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTB &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRB &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTB &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LedMask) + { + PORTB |= LedMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LedMask) + { + PORTB &= ~LedMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LedMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB & ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS) | LedMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LedMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB & ~LedMask) | ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINB = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (PORTB & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAIN/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAIN/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..713e065697 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAIN/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,89 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the original Atmel XPLAIN. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_XPLAIN + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_XPLAIN_REV1 XPLAIN_REV1 + * \brief Board specific information header for the original Atmel XPLAIN, revision 1. + * + * See \ref Group_BoardInfo_XPLAIN for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_XPLAIN XPLAIN + * \brief Board specific information header for the original Atmel XPLAIN. + * + * Board specific information header for the original Atmel XPLAIN. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_XPLAIN_H__ +#define __BOARD_XPLAIN_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Dataflash.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Dataflash mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_DATAFLASH + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAIN/Dataflash.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAIN/Dataflash.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ed6a48c6a9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAIN/Dataflash.h @@ -0,0 +1,245 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Dataflash driver header for the original Atmel XPLAIN. + * \copydetails Group_Dataflash_XPLAIN + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the dataflash driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Dataflash + * \defgroup Group_Dataflash_XPLAIN_REV1 XPLAIN_REV1 + * \brief Board specific Dataflash driver header for the original Atmel XPLAIN, revision 1. + * + * See \ref Group_Dataflash_XPLAIN for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Dataflash + * \defgroup Group_Dataflash_XPLAIN XPLAIN + * \brief Board specific Dataflash driver header for the original Atmel XPLAIN. + * + * \note For the first revision XPLAIN board, compile with <code>BOARD = BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1</code>. + * + * Board specific Dataflash driver header for the Atmel XPLAIN. + * + * <b>Revision 1 Boards</b>: + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Select Pin</th><th>SPI Port</th></tr> + * <tr><td>DATAFLASH_CHIP1</td><td>AT45DB041D (512KB)</td><td>PORTB.5</td><td>SPI0</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * <b>Other Board Revisions</b>: + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Select Pin</th><th>SPI Port</th></tr> + * <tr><td>DATAFLASH_CHIP1</td><td>AT45DB642D (8MB)</td><td>PORTB.5</td><td>SPI0</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __DATAFLASH_XPLAIN_H__ +#define __DATAFLASH_XPLAIN_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + #include "../../../Misc/AT45DB642D.h" + #include "../../../Peripheral/SPI.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_DATAFLASH_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK DATAFLASH_CHIP1 + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_DDR DDRB + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT PORTB + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Constant indicating the total number of dataflash ICs mounted on the selected board. */ + #define DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS 1 + + /** Mask for no dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP 0 + + /** Mask for the first dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIP1 (1 << 5) + + #if ((BOARD != BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + /** Internal main memory page size for the board's dataflash ICs. */ + #define DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE 1024 + + /** Total number of pages inside each of the board's dataflash ICs. */ + #define DATAFLASH_PAGES 8192 + #else + #define DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE 256 + + #define DATAFLASH_PAGES 2048 + #endif + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initializes the dataflash driver so that commands and data may be sent to an attached dataflash IC. + * The appropriate SPI interface will be automatically configured. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_Init(void) + { + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_DDR |= DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK; + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT |= DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK; + + SPI_Init(SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_2 | SPI_ORDER_MSB_FIRST | SPI_SCK_LEAD_FALLING | SPI_SAMPLE_TRAILING | SPI_MODE_MASTER); + } + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns a byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + return SPI_TransferByte(Byte); + } + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and ignores the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + SPI_SendByte(Byte); + } + + /** Sends a dummy byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) + { + return SPI_ReceiveByte(); + } + + /** Determines the currently selected dataflash chip. + * + * \return Mask of the currently selected Dataflash chip, either \ref DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP if no chip is selected + * or a DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is the chip number). + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) + { + return (~DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT & DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK); + } + + /** Selects the given dataflash chip. + * + * \param[in] ChipMask Mask of the Dataflash IC to select, in the form of a \c DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is + * the chip number). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) + { + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT = ((DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT | DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK) & ~ChipMask); + } + + /** Deselects the current dataflash chip, so that no dataflash is selected. */ + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) + { + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP); + } + + /** Selects a dataflash IC from the given page number, which should range from 0 to + * ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). For boards containing only one + * dataflash IC, this will select DATAFLASH_CHIP1. If the given page number is outside + * the total number of pages contained in the boards dataflash ICs, all dataflash ICs + * are deselected. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Address of the page to manipulate, ranging from + * 0 to ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(const uint16_t PageAddress) + { + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + if (PageAddress >= DATAFLASH_PAGES) + return; + + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + } + + /** Toggles the select line of the currently selected dataflash IC, so that it is ready to receive + * a new command. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(void) + { + uint8_t SelectedChipMask = Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(); + + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + Dataflash_SelectChip(SelectedChipMask); + } + + /** Spin-loops while the currently selected dataflash is busy executing a command, such as a main + * memory page program or main memory to buffer transfer. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(void) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + while (!(Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_READY)); + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + } + + /** Sends a set of page and buffer address bytes to the currently selected dataflash IC, for use with + * dataflash commands which require a complete 24-bit address. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Page address within the selected dataflash IC + * \param[in] BufferByte Address within the dataflash's buffer + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(uint16_t PageAddress, + const uint16_t BufferByte) + { + Dataflash_SendByte(PageAddress >> 5); + Dataflash_SendByte((PageAddress << 3) | (BufferByte >> 8)); + Dataflash_SendByte(BufferByte); + } + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAIN/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAIN/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9da3fade53 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAIN/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,142 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the original Atmel XPLAIN. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_XPLAIN + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_XPLAIN_REV1 XPLAIN_REV1 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the original Atmel XPLAIN, revision 1. + * + * See \ref Group_LEDs_XPLAIN for more details. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_XPLAIN XPLAIN + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the original Atmel XPLAIN. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel XPLAIN. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTB.6</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_XPLAIN_H__ +#define __LEDS_XPLAIN_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRB |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTB |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRB &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTB &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB | LEDS_ALL_LEDS) & ~LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB | LEDMask) & ~ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINB = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (~PORTB & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAINED_MINI/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAINED_MINI/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2253e33ea3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAINED_MINI/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel Xplained-MINI series kits. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_XPLAINED_MINI + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_XPLAINED_MINI XPLAINED_MINI + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel Xplained-MINI series kits. + * + * Board specific information header for the Atmel Xplained-MINI series kits. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_XPLAINED_MINI_H__ +#define __BOARD_XPLAINED_MINI_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAINED_MINI/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAINED_MINI/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5c8f1967b0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAINED_MINI/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,135 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel Xplained-MINI series kits.. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_XPLAINED_MINI + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_XPLAINED_MINI XPLAINED_MINI + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel Xplained-MINI series kits. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel Xplained-MINI series kits. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTC.6</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_XPLAINED_MINI_H__ +#define __LEDS_XPLAINED_MINI_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRC |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTC |= LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRC &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + PORTC &= ~LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTC &= ~LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTC |= LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTC = ((PORTC | LEDS_ALL_LEDS) & ~LEDMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTC = ((PORTC | LEDMask) & ~ActiveMask); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINC = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (~PORTC & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/YUN/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/YUN/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..035f66a52b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/YUN/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Arduino Yun board. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_YUN + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_YUN YUN + * \brief Board specific information header for the Arduino Yun board. + * + * Board specific information header for the Arduino Yun board (http://arduino.cc/en/Main/arduinoBoardYun). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_YUN_H__ +#define __BOARD_YUN_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/YUN/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/YUN/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d06acd7e32 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/AVR8/YUN/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,169 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Arduino Yun board. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_YUN + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_YUN YUN + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Arduino Yun board. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Arduino Yun board (http://arduino.cc/en/Main/arduinoBoardYun). + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Yellow</td><td>RX</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTB.0</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Yellow</td><td>TX</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Red</td><td>General Indicator</td><td>High</td><td>PORTC.7</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_YUN_H__ +#define __LEDS_YUN_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define LEDS_PORTB_LEDS (LEDS_LED1) + #define LEDS_PORTD_LEDS (LEDS_LED2) + #define LEDS_PORTC_LEDS (LEDS_LED3) + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 0) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 7) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + DDRB |= LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + PORTB |= LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + DDRD |= LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + PORTD |= LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + DDRC |= LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + PORTC &= ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + DDRB &= ~LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + PORTB &= ~LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + DDRD &= ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + PORTD &= ~LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + DDRC &= ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + PORTC &= ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTD &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PORTC |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTD |= (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PORTC &= ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB | LEDS_PORTB_LEDS) & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS)); + PORTD = ((PORTD | LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS)); + PORTC = ((PORTC & ~LEDS_PORTC_LEDS) | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS)); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTB = ((PORTB | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS)) & ~(ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS)); + PORTD = ((PORTD | (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS)) & ~(ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS)); + PORTC = ((PORTC & ~(LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS)) | (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS)); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PINB = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PIND = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + PINC = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS); + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return ((~PORTB & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS) | (~PORTD & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS) | (PORTC & LEDS_PORTC_LEDS)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3b28e6cca3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,173 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board hardware information driver. + * + * This file is the master dispatch header file for the board-specific information driver, to give information + * on the hardware contained on a specific board. + * + * User code should include this file, which will in turn include the correct board driver header file for the + * currently selected board. + * + * If the \c BOARD value is set to \c BOARD_USER, this will include the \c /Board/Board.h file in the user project + * directory. + * + * For possible \c BOARD makefile values, see \ref Group_BoardTypes. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardDrivers + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo Board Information Driver - LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h + * \brief Board hardware information driver. + * + * \section Sec_BoardInfo_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - None + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_H__ +#define __BOARD_H__ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Common/Common.h" + + #if (BOARD == BOARD_USBKEY) + #include "AVR8/USBKEY/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_STK525) + #include "AVR8/STK525/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_STK526) + #include "AVR8/STK526/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_RZUSBSTICK) + #include "AVR8/RZUSBSTICK/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_ATAVRUSBRF01) + #include "AVR8/ATAVRUSBRF01/Board.h" + #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + #include "AVR8/XPLAIN/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_BUMBLEB) + #include "AVR8/BUMBLEB/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_EVK527) + #include "AVR8/EVK527/Board.h" + #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_TEENSY) || (BOARD == BOARD_TEENSY2)) + #include "AVR8/TEENSY/Board.h" + #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_QMK)) + #include "AVR8/QMK/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_USBTINYMKII) + #include "AVR8/USBTINYMKII/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_BENITO) + #include "AVR8/BENITO/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_JMDBU2) + #include "AVR8/JMDBU2/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_OLIMEX162) + #include "AVR8/OLIMEX162/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_USBFOO) + #include "AVR8/USBFOO/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_UDIP) + #include "AVR8/UDIP/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_BUI) + #include "AVR8/BUI/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_UNO) + #include "AVR8/UNO/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_CULV3) + #include "AVR8/CULV3/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_BLACKCAT) + #include "AVR8/BLACKCAT/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MAXIMUS) + #include "AVR8/MAXIMUS/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MINIMUS) + #include "AVR8/MINIMUS/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_ADAFRUITU4) + #include "AVR8/ADAFRUITU4/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MICROSIN162) + #include "AVR8/MICROSIN162/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_SPARKFUN8U2) + #include "AVR8/SPARKFUN8U2/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_EVK1101) + #include "UC3/EVK1101/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_TUL) + #include "AVR8/TUL/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_EVK1100) + #include "UC3/EVK1100/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_EVK1104) + #include "UC3/EVK1104/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_A3BU_XPLAINED) + #include "XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/Board.h" + #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX) || (BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX_V3) || (BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX_V31)) + #include "AVR8/USB2AX/Board.h" + #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV1) || (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV2) || \ + (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_32U2) || (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_A) || \ + (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_1) || (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_2) || \ + (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_3) || (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_4) || \ + (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_DIP)) + #include "AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_B1_XPLAINED) + #include "XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MULTIO) + #include "AVR8/MULTIO/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_BIGMULTIO) + #include "AVR8/BIGMULTIO/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_DUCE) + #include "AVR8/DUCE/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_OLIMEX32U4) + #include "AVR8/OLIMEX32U4/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_OLIMEXT32U4) + #include "AVR8/OLIMEXT32U4/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_OLIMEXISPMK2) + #include "AVR8/OLIMEXISPMK2/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_LEONARDO) + #include "AVR8/LEONARDO/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_UC3A3_XPLAINED) + #include "UC3/UC3A3_XPLAINED/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_STANGE_ISP) + #include "AVR8/STANGE_ISP/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_C3_XPLAINED) + #include "XMEGA/C3_XPLAINED/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_U2S) + #include "AVR8/U2S/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_YUN) + #include "AVR8/YUN/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MICRO) + #include "AVR8/MICRO/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_POLOLUMICRO) + #include "AVR8/POLOLUMICRO/Board.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAINED_MINI) + #include "AVR8/XPLAINED_MINI/Board.h" + #else + #include "Board/Board.h" + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..00ebe8c15d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,189 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Digital button board hardware driver. + * + * This file is the master dispatch header file for the board-specific Buttons driver, for boards containing + * physical pushbuttons connected to the microcontroller's GPIO pins. + * + * User code should include this file, which will in turn include the correct Button driver header file for the + * currently selected board. + * + * If the \c BOARD value is set to \c BOARD_USER, this will include the \c /Board/Buttons.h file in the user project + * directory. + * + * For possible \c BOARD makefile values, see \ref Group_BoardTypes. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardDrivers + * \defgroup Group_Buttons Buttons Driver - LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h + * \brief Digital button board hardware driver. + * + * \section Sec_Buttons_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - None + * + * \section Sec_Buttons_ModDescription Module Description + * Hardware buttons driver. This provides an easy to use driver for the hardware buttons present on many boards. + * It provides a way to easily configure and check the status of all the buttons on the board so that appropriate + * actions can be taken. + * + * If the \c BOARD value is set to \c BOARD_USER, this will include the \c /Board/Buttons.h file in the user project + * directory. Otherwise, it will include the appropriate built-in board driver header file. + * + * For possible \c BOARD makefile values, see \ref Group_BoardTypes. + * + * \section Sec_Buttons_ExampleUsage Example Usage + * The following snippet is an example of how this module may be used within a typical + * application. + * + * \code + * // Initialize the button driver before first use + * Buttons_Init(); + * + * printf("Waiting for button press...\r\n"); + * + * // Loop until a board button has been pressed + * uint8_t ButtonPress; + * while (!(ButtonPress = Buttons_GetStatus())) {}; + * + * // Display which button was pressed (assuming two board buttons) + * printf("Button pressed: %s\r\n", (ButtonPress == BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ? "Button 1" : "Button 2"); + * \endcode + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_H__ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Common/Common.h" + + #if (BOARD == BOARD_NONE) + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 0 + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) {} + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) {} + static inline uint_reg_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) { return 0; } + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_USBKEY) + #include "AVR8/USBKEY/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_STK525) + #include "AVR8/STK525/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_STK526) + #include "AVR8/STK526/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_ATAVRUSBRF01) + #include "AVR8/ATAVRUSBRF01/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_BUMBLEB) + #include "AVR8/BUMBLEB/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_EVK527) + #include "AVR8/EVK527/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_USBTINYMKII) + #include "AVR8/USBTINYMKII/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_BENITO) + #include "AVR8/BENITO/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_JMDBU2) + #include "AVR8/JMDBU2/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_OLIMEX162) + #include "AVR8/OLIMEX162/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_USBFOO) + #include "AVR8/USBFOO/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_UDIP) + #include "AVR8/UDIP/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_CULV3) + #include "AVR8/CULV3/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MINIMUS) + #include "AVR8/MINIMUS/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MICROSIN162) + #include "AVR8/MICROSIN162/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_EVK1101) + #include "UC3/EVK1101/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_TUL) + #include "AVR8/TUL/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_EVK1100) + #include "UC3/EVK1100/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_EVK1104) + #include "UC3/EVK1104/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_A3BU_XPLAINED) + #include "XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/Buttons.h" + #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX) || (BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX_V3)) + #include "AVR8/USB2AX/Buttons.h" + #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_32U2) || (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_A) || \ + (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_1) || (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_2) || \ + (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_3) || (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_4) || \ + (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV1) || (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV2) || \ + (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_DIP)) + #include "AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_B1_XPLAINED) + #include "XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_OLIMEX32U4) + #include "AVR8/OLIMEX32U4/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_OLIMEXT32U4) + #include "AVR8/OLIMEXT32U4/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_OLIMEXISPMK2) + #include "AVR8/OLIMEXISPMK2/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_UC3A3_XPLAINED) + #include "UC3/UC3A3_XPLAINED/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_STANGE_ISP) + #include "AVR8/STANGE_ISP/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_C3_XPLAINED) + #include "XMEGA/C3_XPLAINED/Buttons.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_U2S) + #include "AVR8/U2S/Buttons.h" + #else + #include "Board/Buttons.h" + #endif + + /* Pseudo-Functions for Doxygen: */ + #if defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Initializes the buttons driver, so that the current button position can be read. This sets the appropriate + * I/O pins to an inputs with pull-ups enabled. + * + * This must be called before any Button driver functions are used. + */ + static inline void Buttons_Init(void); + + /** Disables the buttons driver, releasing the I/O pins back to their default high-impedance input mode. */ + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void); + + /** Returns a mask indicating which board buttons are currently pressed. + * + * \return Mask of \c BUTTONS_BUTTON* constants indicating which board buttons are currently pressed. + */ + static inline uint_reg_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b634dccaa6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h @@ -0,0 +1,264 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Master include file for the board dataflash IC driver. + * \brief Atmel Dataflash storage IC board hardware driver. + * + * This file is the master dispatch header file for the board-specific Atmel dataflash driver, for boards containing + * Atmel Dataflash ICs for external non-volatile storage. + * + * User code should include this file, which will in turn include the correct dataflash driver header file for + * the currently selected board. + * + * If the \c BOARD value is set to \c BOARD_USER, this will include the \c /Board/Dataflash.h file in the user project + * directory. + * + * For possible \c BOARD makefile values, see \ref Group_BoardTypes. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardDrivers + * \defgroup Group_Dataflash Dataflash Driver - LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h + * \brief Atmel Dataflash storage IC board hardware driver. + * + * \section Sec_Dataflash_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - None + * + * \section Sec_Dataflash_ModDescription Module Description + * Dataflash driver. This module provides an easy to use interface for the Dataflash ICs located on many boards, + * for the storage of large amounts of data into the Dataflash's non-volatile memory. + * + * If the \c BOARD value is set to \c BOARD_USER, this will include the \c /Board/Dataflash.h file in the user project + * directory. Otherwise, it will include the appropriate built-in board driver header file. + * + * For possible \c BOARD makefile values, see \ref Group_BoardTypes. + * + * \section Sec_Dataflash_ExampleUsage Example Usage + * The following snippet is an example of how this module may be used within a typical + * application. + * + * \code + * // Initialize the board Dataflash driver before first use + * Dataflash_Init(); + * + * uint8_t WriteBuffer[DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE]; + * uint8_t ReadBuffer[DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE]; + * + * // Fill page write buffer with a repeating pattern + * for (uint16_t i = 0; i < DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE; i++) + * WriteBuffer[i] = (i & 0xFF); + * + * // Must select the chip of interest first before operating on it + * Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + * + * // Write to the Dataflash's first internal memory buffer + * printf("Writing data to first dataflash buffer:\r\n"); + * Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + * Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, 0); + * + * for (uint16_t i = 0; i < DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE; i++) + * Dataflash_SendByte(WriteBuffer[i]); + * + * // Commit the Dataflash's first memory buffer to the non-volatile FLASH memory + * printf("Committing page to non-volatile memory page index 5:\r\n"); + * Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + * Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(5, 0); + * Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + * + * // Read the page from non-volatile FLASH memory into the Dataflash's second memory buffer + * printf("Reading data into second dataflash buffer:\r\n"); + * Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF2); + * Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(5, 0); + * Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + * + * // Read the Dataflash's second internal memory buffer + * Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_BUFF2READ); + * Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, 0); + * + * for (uint16_t i = 0; i < DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE; i++) + * ReadBuffer[i] = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + * + * // Deselect the chip after use + * Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + * \endcode + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __DATAFLASH_H__ +#define __DATAFLASH_H__ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_DATAFLASH_H + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Retrieves the Dataflash chip select mask for the given Dataflash chip index. + * + * \attention This macro will only work correctly on chip index numbers that are compile-time + * constants defined by the preprocessor. + * + * \param[in] index Index of the dataflash chip mask to retrieve. + * + * \return Mask for the given Dataflash chip's /CS pin + */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIP_MASK(index) CONCAT_EXPANDED(DATAFLASH_CHIP, index) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initializes the dataflash driver so that commands and data may be sent to an attached dataflash IC. + * + * \note The microcontroller's physical interface driver connected to the Dataflash IC must be initialized before + * any of the dataflash commands are used. This is usually a SPI hardware port, but on some devices/boards may + * be a USART operating in SPI Master mode. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_Init(void); + + /** Determines the currently selected dataflash chip. + * + * \return Mask of the currently selected Dataflash chip, either \ref DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP if no chip is selected + * or a \c DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is the chip number). + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + + /** Selects the given dataflash chip. + * + * \param[in] ChipMask Mask of the Dataflash IC to select, in the form of a \c DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is + * the chip number). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + + /** Deselects the current dataflash chip, so that no dataflash is selected. */ + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + + /** Selects a dataflash IC from the given page number, which should range from 0 to + * ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). For boards containing only one + * dataflash IC, this will select \ref DATAFLASH_CHIP1. If the given page number is outside + * the total number of pages contained in the boards dataflash ICs, all dataflash ICs + * are deselected. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Address of the page to manipulate, ranging from + * 0 to ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(const uint16_t PageAddress); + + /** Toggles the select line of the currently selected dataflash IC, so that it is ready to receive + * a new command. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(void); + + /** Spin-loops while the currently selected dataflash is busy executing a command, such as a main + * memory page program or main memory to buffer transfer. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(void); + + /** Sends a set of page and buffer address bytes to the currently selected dataflash IC, for use with + * dataflash commands which require a complete 24-bit address. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Page address within the selected dataflash IC + * \param[in] BufferByte Address within the dataflash's buffer + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(uint16_t PageAddress, + const uint16_t BufferByte); + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns a byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and ignores the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + + /** Sends a dummy byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + + /* Includes: */ + #if (BOARD == BOARD_NONE) + #define DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS 0 + #define DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP 0 + #define DATAFLASH_CHIP1 0 + #define DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE 0 + #define DATAFLASH_PAGES 0 + static inline void Dataflash_Init(void) {}; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) { return 0; }; + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) {}; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) { return 0; }; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) { return 0; }; + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) {}; + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) {}; + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(const uint16_t PageAddress) {}; + static inline void Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(void) {}; + static inline void Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(void) {}; + static inline void Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(uint16_t PageAddress, + const uint16_t BufferByte) {}; + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_USBKEY) + #include "AVR8/USBKEY/Dataflash.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_STK525) + #include "AVR8/STK525/Dataflash.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_STK526) + #include "AVR8/STK526/Dataflash.h" + #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + #include "AVR8/XPLAIN/Dataflash.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_EVK527) + #include "AVR8/EVK527/Dataflash.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_A3BU_XPLAINED) + #include "XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/Dataflash.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_B1_XPLAINED) + #include "XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/Dataflash.h" + #else + #include "Board/Dataflash.h" + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0d0fe89344 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h @@ -0,0 +1,152 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Digital joystick board hardware driver. + * + * This file is the master dispatch header file for the board-specific Joystick driver, for boards containing a + * digital joystick. + * + * User code should include this file, which will in turn include the correct joystick driver header file for the + * currently selected board. + * + * If the \c BOARD value is set to \c BOARD_USER, this will include the \c /Board/Joystick.h file in the user project + * directory. + * + * For possible \c BOARD makefile values, see \ref Group_BoardTypes. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardDrivers + * \defgroup Group_Joystick Joystick Driver - LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h + * \brief Digital joystick board hardware driver. + * + * \section Sec_Joystick_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - None + * + * \section Sec_Joystick_ModDescription Module Description + * Hardware Joystick driver. This module provides an easy to use interface to control the hardware digital Joystick + * located on many boards. + * + * If the \c BOARD value is set to \c BOARD_USER, this will include the \c /Board/Joystick.h file in the user project + * directory. Otherwise, it will include the appropriate built-in board driver header file. + * + * For possible \c BOARD makefile values, see \ref Group_BoardTypes. + * + * \section Sec_Joystick_ExampleUsage Example Usage + * The following snippet is an example of how this module may be used within a typical + * application. + * + * \code + * // Initialize the board Joystick driver before first use + * Joystick_Init(); + * + * printf("Waiting for joystick movement...\r\n"); + * + * // Loop until a the joystick has been moved + * uint8_t JoystickMovement; + * while (!(JoystickMovement = Joystick_GetStatus())) {}; + * + * // Display which direction the joystick was moved in + * printf("Joystick moved:\r\n"); + * + * if (JoystickMovement & (JOY_UP | JOY_DOWN)) + * printf("%s ", (JoystickMovement & JOY_UP) ? "Up" : "Down"); + * + * if (JoystickMovement & (JOY_LEFT | JOY_RIGHT)) + * printf("%s ", (JoystickMovement & JOY_LEFT) ? "Left" : "Right"); + * + * if (JoystickMovement & JOY_PRESS) + * printf("Pressed"); + * \endcode + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __JOYSTICK_H__ +#define __JOYSTICK_H__ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_JOYSTICK_H + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Common/Common.h" + + #if (BOARD == BOARD_NONE) + #define JOY_UP 0 + #define JOY_DOWN 0 + #define JOY_LEFT 0 + #define JOY_RIGHT 0 + #define JOY_PRESS 0 + static inline void Joystick_Init(void) {} + static inline void Joystick_Disable(void) {} + static inline uint_reg_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) { return 0; } + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_USBKEY) + #include "AVR8/USBKEY/Joystick.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_STK525) + #include "AVR8/STK525/Joystick.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_STK526) + #include "AVR8/STK526/Joystick.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_BUMBLEB) + #include "AVR8/BUMBLEB/Joystick.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_EVK527) + #include "AVR8/EVK527/Joystick.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_EVK1101) + #include "UC3/EVK1101/Joystick.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_EVK1100) + #include "UC3/EVK1100/Joystick.h" + #else + #include "Board/Joystick.h" + #endif + + /* Pseudo-Functions for Doxygen: */ + #if defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Initializes the joystick driver so that the joystick position can be read. This sets the appropriate + * I/O pins to inputs with their pull-ups enabled. + * + * This must be called before any Joystick driver functions are used. + */ + static inline void Joystick_Init(void); + + /** Disables the joystick driver, releasing the I/O pins back to their default high-impedance input mode. */ + static inline void Joystick_Disable(void); + + /** Returns the current status of the joystick, as a mask indicating the direction the joystick is + * currently facing in (multiple bits can be set). + * + * \return Mask of \c JOYSTICK_* constants indicating the current joystick direction(s). + */ + static inline uint_reg_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..74abb37238 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,304 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LED board hardware driver. + * + * This file is the master dispatch header file for the board-specific LED driver, for boards containing user + * controllable LEDs. + * + * User code should include this file, which will in turn include the correct LED driver header file for the + * currently selected board. + * + * If the \c BOARD value is set to \c BOARD_USER, this will include the \c /Board/LEDs.h file in the user project + * directory. + * + * For possible \c BOARD makefile values, see \ref Group_BoardTypes. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardDrivers + * \defgroup Group_LEDs LEDs Driver - LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h + * \brief LED board hardware driver. + * + * \section Sec_LEDs_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - None + * + * \section Sec_LEDs_ModDescription Module Description + * Hardware LEDs driver. This provides an easy to use driver for the hardware LEDs present on many boards. It + * provides an interface to configure, test and change the status of all the board LEDs. + * + * If the \c BOARD value is set to \c BOARD_USER, this will include the \c /Board/LEDs.h file in the user project + * directory. Otherwise, it will include the appropriate built-in board driver header file. If the BOARD value + * is set to \c BOARD_NONE, this driver is silently disabled. + * + * For possible \c BOARD makefile values, see \ref Group_BoardTypes. + * + * \note To make code as compatible as possible, it is assumed that all boards carry a minimum of four LEDs. If + * a board contains less than four LEDs, the remaining LED masks are defined to 0 so as to have no effect. + * If other behavior is desired, either alias the remaining LED masks to existing LED masks via the -D + * switch in the project makefile, or alias them to nothing in the makefile to cause compilation errors when + * a non-existing LED is referenced in application code. Note that this means that it is possible to make + * compatible code for a board with no LEDs by making a board LED driver (see \ref Page_WritingBoardDrivers) + * which contains only stub functions and defines no LEDs. + * + * \section Sec_LEDs_ExampleUsage Example Usage + * The following snippet is an example of how this module may be used within a typical + * application. + * + * \code + * // Initialize the board LED driver before first use + * LEDs_Init(); + * + * // Turn on each of the four LEDs in turn + * LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDS_LED1); + * Delay_MS(500); + * LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDS_LED2); + * Delay_MS(500); + * LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDS_LED3); + * Delay_MS(500); + * LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDS_LED4); + * Delay_MS(500); + * + * // Turn on all LEDs + * LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + * Delay_MS(1000); + * + * // Turn on LED 1, turn off LED 2, leaving LEDs 3 and 4 in their current state + * LEDs_ChangeLEDs((LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2), LEDS_LED1); + * \endcode + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_H__ +#define __LEDS_H__ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Common/Common.h" + + #if (BOARD == BOARD_NONE) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) {} + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) {} + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint_reg_t LEDMask) {} + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint_reg_t LEDMask) {} + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint_reg_t LEDMask) {} + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint_reg_t LEDMask, const uint_reg_t ActiveMask) {} + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint_reg_t LEDMask) {} + static inline uint_reg_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) { return 0; } + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_USBKEY) + #include "AVR8/USBKEY/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_STK525) + #include "AVR8/STK525/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_STK526) + #include "AVR8/STK526/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_RZUSBSTICK) + #include "AVR8/RZUSBSTICK/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_ATAVRUSBRF01) + #include "AVR8/ATAVRUSBRF01/LEDs.h" + #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + #include "AVR8/XPLAIN/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_BUMBLEB) + #include "AVR8/BUMBLEB/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_EVK527) + #include "AVR8/EVK527/LEDs.h" + #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_TEENSY) || (BOARD == BOARD_TEENSY2)) + #include "AVR8/TEENSY/LEDs.h" + #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_QMK)) + #include "AVR8/QMK/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_USBTINYMKII) + #include "AVR8/USBTINYMKII/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_BENITO) + #include "AVR8/BENITO/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_JMDBU2) + #include "AVR8/JMDBU2/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_OLIMEX162) + #include "AVR8/OLIMEX162/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_USBFOO) + #include "AVR8/USBFOO/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_UDIP) + #include "AVR8/UDIP/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_BUI) + #include "AVR8/BUI/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_UNO) + #include "AVR8/UNO/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_CULV3) + #include "AVR8/CULV3/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_BLACKCAT) + #include "AVR8/BLACKCAT/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MAXIMUS) + #include "AVR8/MAXIMUS/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MINIMUS) + #include "AVR8/MINIMUS/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_ADAFRUITU4) + #include "AVR8/ADAFRUITU4/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MICROSIN162) + #include "AVR8/MICROSIN162/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_SPARKFUN8U2) + #include "AVR8/SPARKFUN8U2/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_EVK1101) + #include "UC3/EVK1101/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_TUL) + #include "AVR8/TUL/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_EVK1100) + #include "UC3/EVK1100/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_EVK1104) + #include "UC3/EVK1104/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_A3BU_XPLAINED) + #include "XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/LEDs.h" + #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX) || (BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX_V3) || (BOARD == BOARD_USB2AX_V31)) + #include "AVR8/USB2AX/LEDs.h" + #elif ((BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV1) || (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV2) || \ + (BOARD == BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_32U2)) + #include "AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_B1_XPLAINED) + #include "XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MULTIO) + #include "AVR8/MULTIO/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_BIGMULTIO) + #include "AVR8/BIGMULTIO/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_DUCE) + #include "AVR8/DUCE/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_OLIMEX32U4) + #include "AVR8/OLIMEX32U4/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_OLIMEXT32U4) + #include "AVR8/OLIMEXT32U4/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_OLIMEXISPMK2) + #include "AVR8/OLIMEXISPMK2/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_LEONARDO) + #include "AVR8/LEONARDO/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_UC3A3_XPLAINED) + #include "UC3/UC3A3_XPLAINED/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_STANGE_ISP) + #include "AVR8/STANGE_ISP/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_C3_XPLAINED) + #include "XMEGA/C3_XPLAINED/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_U2S) + #include "AVR8/U2S/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_YUN) + #include "AVR8/YUN/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_MICRO) + #include "AVR8/MICRO/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_POLOLUMICRO) + #include "AVR8/POLOLUMICRO/LEDs.h" + #elif (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAINED_MINI) + #include "AVR8/XPLAINED_MINI/LEDs.h" + #else + #include "Board/LEDs.h" + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #if !defined(LEDS_NO_LEDS) + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + #endif + + #if !defined(LEDS_ALL_LEDS) + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + #endif + + #if !defined(LEDS_LED1) + #define LEDS_LED1 0 + #endif + + #if !defined(LEDS_LED2) + #define LEDS_LED2 0 + #endif + + #if !defined(LEDS_LED3) + #define LEDS_LED3 0 + #endif + + #if !defined(LEDS_LED4) + #define LEDS_LED4 0 + #endif + #endif + + /* Pseudo-Functions for Doxygen: */ + #if defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Initializes the board LED driver so that the LEDs can be controlled. This sets the appropriate port + * I/O pins as outputs, and sets the LEDs to default to off. + * + * This must be called before any LED driver functions are used. + */ + static inline void LEDs_Init(void); + + /** Disables the board LED driver, releasing the I/O pins back to their default high-impedance input mode. */ + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void); + + /** Turns on the LEDs specified in the given LED mask. + * + * \param[in] LEDMask Mask of the board LEDs to manipulate (see board-specific LEDs.h driver file). + */ + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint_reg_t LEDMask); + + /** Turns off the LEDs specified in the given LED mask. + * + * \param[in] LEDMask Mask of the board LEDs to manipulate (see board-specific LEDs.h driver file). + */ + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint_reg_t LEDMask); + + /** Turns off all LEDs not specified in the given LED mask, and turns on all the LEDs in the given LED + * mask. + * + * \param[in] LEDMask Mask of the board LEDs to manipulate (see board-specific LEDs.h driver file). + */ + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint_reg_t LEDMask); + + /** Turns off all LEDs in the LED mask that are not set in the active mask, and turns on all the LEDs + * specified in both the LED and active masks. + * + * \param[in] LEDMask Mask of the board LEDs to manipulate (see board-specific LEDs.h driver file). + * \param[in] ActiveMask Mask of whether the LEDs in the LED mask should be turned on or off. + */ + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint_reg_t LEDMask, + const uint_reg_t ActiveMask); + + /** Toggles all LEDs in the LED mask, leaving all others in their current states. + * + * \param[in] LEDMask Mask of the board LEDs to manipulate (see board-specific LEDs.h driver file). + */ + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint_reg_t LEDMask); + + /** Returns the status of all the board LEDs; set LED masks in the return value indicate that the + * corresponding LED is on. + * + * \return Mask of \c LEDS_LED* constants indicating which of the board LEDs are currently turned on. + */ + static inline uint_reg_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Temperature.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Temperature.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2fb1976272 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Temperature.c @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_TEMPERATURE_C +#include "Temperature.h" + +#if defined(TEMPERATURE_SENSOR_DRIVER_COMPATIBLE) + +static const uint16_t PROGMEM Temperature_Lookup[TEMP_TABLE_SIZE] = +{ + 0x3B4, 0x3B0, 0x3AB, 0x3A6, 0x3A0, 0x39A, 0x394, 0x38E, 0x388, 0x381, 0x37A, 0x373, + 0x36B, 0x363, 0x35B, 0x353, 0x34A, 0x341, 0x338, 0x32F, 0x325, 0x31B, 0x311, 0x307, + 0x2FC, 0x2F1, 0x2E6, 0x2DB, 0x2D0, 0x2C4, 0x2B8, 0x2AC, 0x2A0, 0x294, 0x288, 0x27C, + 0x26F, 0x263, 0x256, 0x24A, 0x23D, 0x231, 0x225, 0x218, 0x20C, 0x200, 0x1F3, 0x1E7, + 0x1DB, 0x1CF, 0x1C4, 0x1B8, 0x1AC, 0x1A1, 0x196, 0x18B, 0x180, 0x176, 0x16B, 0x161, + 0x157, 0x14D, 0x144, 0x13A, 0x131, 0x128, 0x11F, 0x117, 0x10F, 0x106, 0x0FE, 0x0F7, + 0x0EF, 0x0E8, 0x0E1, 0x0DA, 0x0D3, 0x0CD, 0x0C7, 0x0C0, 0x0BA, 0x0B5, 0x0AF, 0x0AA, + 0x0A4, 0x09F, 0x09A, 0x096, 0x091, 0x08C, 0x088, 0x084, 0x080, 0x07C, 0x078, 0x074, + 0x071, 0x06D, 0x06A, 0x067, 0x064, 0x061, 0x05E, 0x05B, 0x058, 0x055, 0x053, 0x050, + 0x04E, 0x04C, 0x049, 0x047, 0x045, 0x043, 0x041, 0x03F, 0x03D, 0x03C, 0x03A, 0x038 +}; + +int8_t Temperature_GetTemperature(void) +{ + uint16_t Temp_ADC = ADC_GetChannelReading(ADC_REFERENCE_AVCC | ADC_RIGHT_ADJUSTED | TEMP_ADC_CHANNEL_MASK); + + if (Temp_ADC > pgm_read_word(&Temperature_Lookup[0])) + return TEMP_MIN_TEMP; + + for (uint16_t Index = 0; Index < TEMP_TABLE_SIZE; Index++) + { + if (Temp_ADC > pgm_read_word(&Temperature_Lookup[Index])) + return (Index + TEMP_TABLE_OFFSET_DEGREES); + } + + return TEMP_MAX_TEMP; +} + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Temperature.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Temperature.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f381cc92d9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Temperature.h @@ -0,0 +1,147 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief NTC Temperature Sensor board hardware driver. + * + * Master include file for the board temperature sensor driver, for the USB boards which contain a temperature sensor. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardDrivers + * \defgroup Group_Temperature Temperature Sensor Driver - LUFA/Drivers/Board/Temperature.h + * \brief NTC Temperature Sensor board hardware driver. + * + * \section Sec_Temperature_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/Board/Temperature.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_TEMPERATURE)</i> + * + * \section Sec_Temperature_ModDescription Module Description + * Temperature sensor driver. This provides an easy to use interface for the hardware temperature sensor located + * on many boards. It provides an interface to configure the sensor and appropriate ADC channel, plus read out the + * current temperature in degrees C. It is designed for and will only work with the temperature sensor located on the + * official Atmel USB AVR boards, as each sensor has different characteristics. + * + * \section Sec_Temperature_ExampleUsage Example Usage + * The following snippet is an example of how this module may be used within a typical + * application. + * + * \code + * // Initialize the ADC and board temperature sensor drivers before first use + * ADC_Init(ADC_FREE_RUNNING | ADC_PRESCALE_128); + * Temperature_Init(); + * + * // Display converted temperature in degrees Celsius + * printf("Current Temperature: %d Degrees\r\n", Temperature_GetTemperature()); + * \endcode + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __TEMPERATURE_H__ +#define __TEMPERATURE_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if ((BOARD == BOARD_USBKEY) || (BOARD == BOARD_STK525) || \ + (BOARD == BOARD_STK526) || (BOARD == BOARD_EVK527)) + #define TEMPERATURE_SENSOR_DRIVER_COMPATIBLE + #endif + + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_TEMPERATURE_C) && !defined(TEMPERATURE_SENSOR_DRIVER_COMPATIBLE) + #error The selected board does not contain a compatible temperature sensor. + #endif + + #if defined(TEMPERATURE_SENSOR_DRIVER_COMPATIBLE) + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../Peripheral/ADC.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** ADC channel number for the temperature sensor. */ + #define TEMP_ADC_CHANNEL 0 + + /** ADC channel MUX mask for the temperature sensor. */ + #define TEMP_ADC_CHANNEL_MASK ADC_CHANNEL0 + + /** Size of the temperature sensor lookup table, in lookup values */ + #define TEMP_TABLE_SIZE 120 + + /** Minimum returnable temperature from the \ref Temperature_GetTemperature() function. */ + #define TEMP_MIN_TEMP TEMP_TABLE_OFFSET_DEGREES + + /** Maximum returnable temperature from the \ref Temperature_GetTemperature() function. */ + #define TEMP_MAX_TEMP ((TEMP_TABLE_SIZE - 1) + TEMP_TABLE_OFFSET_DEGREES) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initializes the temperature sensor driver, including setting up the appropriate ADC channel. + * This must be called before any other temperature sensor routines. + * + * \pre The ADC itself (not the ADC channel) must be configured separately before calling the + * temperature sensor functions. + */ + static inline void Temperature_Init(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Temperature_Init(void) + { + ADC_SetupChannel(TEMP_ADC_CHANNEL); + } + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Performs a complete ADC on the temperature sensor channel, and converts the result into a + * valid temperature between \ref TEMP_MIN_TEMP and \ref TEMP_MAX_TEMP in degrees Celsius. + * + * \return Signed temperature value in degrees Celsius. + */ + int8_t Temperature_GetTemperature(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define TEMP_TABLE_OFFSET_DEGREES -21 + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1100/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1100/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bd68cf5774 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1100/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,86 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel EVK1100. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_EVK1100 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_EVK1100 EVK1100 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel Atmel EVK1100. + * + * Board specific information header for the Atmel Atmel EVK1100. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_EVK1100_H__ +#define __BOARD_EVK1100_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../Joystick.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Joystick mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_JOYSTICK + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1100/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1100/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a2bd15d285 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1100/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,117 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel EVK1100. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_EVK1100 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_EVK1100 EVK1100 + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel EVK1100. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel EVK1100. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>SW0 Button</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO88</td></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON2</td><td>SW1 Button</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO85</td></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON3</td><td>SW2 Button</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO82</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_EVK1100_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_EVK1100_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define BUTTONS_PORT 2 + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Mask of the first button on the board */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1UL << 24) + + /** Mask of the second button on the board */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON2 (1UL << 21) + + /** Mask of the third button on the board */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON3 (1UL << 18) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[BUTTONS_PORT].gpers = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2); + AVR32_GPIO.port[BUTTONS_PORT].puers = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2); + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[BUTTONS_PORT].gperc = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2); + AVR32_GPIO.port[BUTTONS_PORT].puerc = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2); + } + + static inline uint32_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint32_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return (~(AVR32_GPIO.port[JOY_MOVE_PORT].pvr & (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2))); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1100/Joystick.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1100/Joystick.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7117bc519d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1100/Joystick.h @@ -0,0 +1,122 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific joystick driver header for the Atmel EVK1100. + * \copydetails Group_Joystick_EVK1100 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the joystick driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Joystick + * \defgroup Group_Joystick_EVK1100 EVK1100 + * \brief Board specific joystick driver header for the Atmel EVK1100. + * + * Board specific joystick driver header for the Atmel EVK1100. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Left Port Pin</th><th>Up Port Pin</th><th>Right Port Pin</th><th>Down Port Pin</th><th>Press Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>GPIO25</td><td>GPIO26</td><td>GPIO28</td><td>GPIO27</td><td>GPIO20</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __JOYSTICK_EVK1100_H__ +#define __JOYSTICK_EVK1100_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_JOYSTICK_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define JOY_PORT 0 + #define JOY_MASK ((1UL << 28) | (1UL << 27) | (1UL << 26) | (1UL << 25) | (1UL << 20)) + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the left direction. */ + #define JOY_LEFT (1UL << 25) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the upward direction. */ + #define JOY_UP (1UL << 26) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the right direction. */ + #define JOY_RIGHT (1UL << 28) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the downward direction. */ + #define JOY_DOWN (1UL << 27) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed inward. */ + #define JOY_PRESS (1UL << 20) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Joystick_Init(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[JOY_PORT].gpers = JOY_MASK; + AVR32_GPIO.port[JOY_PORT].gpers = JOY_MASK; + }; + + static inline void Joystick_Disable(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[JOY_PORT].gperc = JOY_MASK; + AVR32_GPIO.port[JOY_PORT].gperc = JOY_MASK; + }; + + static inline uint32_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint32_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) + { + return (uint32_t)(~(AVR32_GPIO.port[JOY_PORT].pvr & JOY_MASK)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1100/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1100/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ca6a37f3ed --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1100/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,173 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel EVK1100. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_EVK1100 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_EVK1100 EVK1100 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel EVK1100. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel EVK1100. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>LED0 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO51</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Green</td><td>LED1 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO52</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Green</td><td>LED2 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO53</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED4</td><td>Green</td><td>LED3 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO54</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED5</td><td>Green</td><td>LED4 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO59</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED6</td><td>Green</td><td>LED5 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO60</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED7</td><td>Green</td><td>LED6 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO61</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED8</td><td>Green</td><td>LED7 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO62</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_EVK1100_H__ +#define __LEDS_EVK1100_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define LEDS_PORT 1 + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1UL << 19) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1UL << 20) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1UL << 21) + + /** LED mask for the fourth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED4 (1UL << 22) + + /** LED mask for the fifth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED5 (1UL << 27) + + /** LED mask for the sixth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED6 (1UL << 28) + + /** LED mask for the seventh LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED7 (1UL << 29) + + /** LED mask for the eighth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED8 (1UL << 30) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4 \ + LEDS_LED5 | LEDS_LED6 | LEDS_LED7 | LEDS_LED8) + + /** LED mask for the none of the board LEDs */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].gpers = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].oders = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovrs = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].gperc = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].oderc = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovrc = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovrc = LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovrs = LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovrs = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovrc = LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask, const uint32_t ActiveMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovrs = LEDMask; + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovrc = ActiveMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovrt = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint32_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint32_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (~AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovr & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1101/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1101/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..46d79f00a4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1101/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,86 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel EVK1101. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_EVK1101 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_EVK1101 EVK1101 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel Atmel EVK1101. + * + * Board specific information header for the Atmel Atmel EVK1101. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_EVK1101_H__ +#define __BOARD_EVK1101_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../Joystick.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Joystick mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_JOYSTICK + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1101/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1101/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..41bf42c668 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1101/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,113 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel EVK1101. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_EVK1101 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_EVK1101 EVK1101 + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel EVK1101. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel EVK1101. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>SW0 Button</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO34</td></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON2</td><td>SW1 Button</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO35</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_EVK1101_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_EVK1101_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define BUTTONS_PORT 1 + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Mask of the first button on the board */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1UL << 2) + + /** Mask of the second button on the board */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON2 (1UL << 3) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[BUTTONS_PORT].gpers = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2); + AVR32_GPIO.port[BUTTONS_PORT].puers = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2); + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[BUTTONS_PORT].gperc = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2); + AVR32_GPIO.port[BUTTONS_PORT].puerc = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2); + } + + static inline uint32_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint32_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return (~(AVR32_GPIO.port[BUTTONS_PORT].pvr & (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2))); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1101/Joystick.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1101/Joystick.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1351213017 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1101/Joystick.h @@ -0,0 +1,131 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific joystick driver header for the Atmel EVK1101. + * \copydetails Group_Joystick_EVK1101 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the joystick driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Joystick + * \defgroup Group_Joystick_EVK1101 EVK1101 + * \brief Board specific joystick driver header for the Atmel EVK1101. + * + * Board specific joystick driver header for the Atmel EVK1101. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Left Port Pin</th><th>Up Port Pin</th><th>Right Port Pin</th><th>Down Port Pin</th><th>Press Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>GPIO38</td><td>GPIO39</td><td>GPIO41</td><td>GPIO40</td><td>GPIO13</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __JOYSTICK_EVK1101_H__ +#define __JOYSTICK_EVK1101_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_JOYSTICK_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define JOY_MOVE_PORT 1 + #define JOY_MOVE_MASK ((1UL << 6) | (1UL << 7) | (1UL << 8) | (1UL << 9)) + #define JOY_PRESS_PORT 0 + #define JOY_PRESS_MASK (1UL << 13) + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the left direction. */ + #define JOY_LEFT (1UL << 6) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the upward direction. */ + #define JOY_UP (1UL << 7) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the right direction. */ + #define JOY_RIGHT (1UL << 9) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed in the downward direction. */ + #define JOY_DOWN (1UL << 8) + + /** Mask for the joystick being pushed inward. */ + #define JOY_PRESS (1UL << 13) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Joystick_Init(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[JOY_MOVE_PORT].gpers = JOY_MOVE_MASK; + AVR32_GPIO.port[JOY_PRESS_PORT].gpers = JOY_PRESS_MASK; + + AVR32_GPIO.port[JOY_MOVE_PORT].puers = JOY_MOVE_MASK; + AVR32_GPIO.port[JOY_PRESS_PORT].puers = JOY_PRESS_MASK; + }; + + static inline void Joystick_Disable(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[JOY_MOVE_PORT].gperc = JOY_MOVE_MASK; + AVR32_GPIO.port[JOY_PRESS_PORT].gperc = JOY_PRESS_MASK; + + AVR32_GPIO.port[JOY_MOVE_PORT].puerc = JOY_MOVE_MASK; + AVR32_GPIO.port[JOY_PRESS_PORT].puerc = JOY_PRESS_MASK; + }; + + static inline uint32_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint32_t Joystick_GetStatus(void) + { + return (uint32_t)(~((AVR32_GPIO.port[JOY_MOVE_PORT].pvr & JOY_MOVE_MASK) | + (AVR32_GPIO.port[JOY_PRESS_PORT].pvr & JOY_PRESS_MASK))); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1101/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1101/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..71d45d2ad3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1101/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,156 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel EVK1101. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_EVK1101 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_EVK1101 EVK1101 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel EVK1101. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel EVK1101. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>LED0 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO7</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Green</td><td>LED1 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO8</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Green</td><td>LED2 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO21</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED4</td><td>Green</td><td>LED3 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO22</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_EVK1101_H__ +#define __LEDS_EVK1101_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define LEDS_PORT 0 + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1UL << 7) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1UL << 8) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1UL << 21) + + /** LED mask for the fourth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED4 (1UL << 22) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the none of the board LEDs */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].gpers = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].oders = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovrs = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].gperc = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].oderc = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovrc = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovrc = LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovrs = LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovrs = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovrc = LEDMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask, const uint32_t ActiveMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovrs = LEDMask; + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovrc = ActiveMask; + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovrt = LEDMask; + } + + static inline uint32_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint32_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return (~AVR32_GPIO.port[LEDS_PORT].ovr & LEDS_ALL_LEDS); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1104/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1104/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0c8b762d71 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1104/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel EVK1104. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_EVK1104 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_EVK1104 EVK1104 + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel Atmel EVK1104. + * + * Board specific information header for the Atmel Atmel EVK1104. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_EVK1104_H__ +#define __BOARD_EVK1104_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1104/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1104/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d12fda5739 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1104/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,109 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel EVK1104. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_EVK1104 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_EVK1104 EVK1104 + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel EVK1104. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel EVK1104. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>SW0 Button</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO42</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_EVK1104_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_EVK1104_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define BUTTONS_PORT 1 + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Mask of the first button on the board */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1UL << 10) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[BUTTONS_PORT].gpers = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2); + AVR32_GPIO.port[BUTTONS_PORT].puers = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2); + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[BUTTONS_PORT].gperc = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2); + AVR32_GPIO.port[BUTTONS_PORT].puerc = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2); + } + + static inline uint32_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint32_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return (~(AVR32_GPIO.port[JOY_MOVE_PORT].pvr & (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2))); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1104/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1104/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..793ea86dea --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1104/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,174 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel EVK1104. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_EVK1104 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_EVK1104 EVK1104 + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel EVK1104. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel EVK1104. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Green</td><td>LED0 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO67</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Green</td><td>LED1 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO101</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Green</td><td>LED2 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO102</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED4</td><td>Green</td><td>LED3 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO105</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_EVK1104_H__ +#define __LEDS_EVK1104_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define LEDS_LEDMASK2 (1UL << 3) + #define LEDS_LEDMASK3 ((1UL << 9) | (1UL << 6) | (1UL << 5)) + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1UL << 3) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1UL << 5) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1UL << 9) + + /** LED mask for the fourth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED4 (1UL << 6) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the none of the board LEDs */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[2].gpers = LEDS_LEDMASK2; + AVR32_GPIO.port[2].oders = LEDS_LEDMASK2; + AVR32_GPIO.port[2].ovrs = LEDS_LEDMASK2; + + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].gpers = LEDS_LEDMASK3; + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].oders = LEDS_LEDMASK3; + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovrs = LEDS_LEDMASK3; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[2].gperc = LEDS_LEDMASK2; + AVR32_GPIO.port[2].oderc = LEDS_LEDMASK2; + AVR32_GPIO.port[2].ovrc = LEDS_LEDMASK2; + + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].gperc = LEDS_LEDMASK3; + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].oderc = LEDS_LEDMASK3; + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovrc = LEDS_LEDMASK3; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[2].ovrc = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK2); + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovrc = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK3); + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[2].ovrs = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK2); + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovrs = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK3); + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[2].ovrs = LEDS_LEDMASK2; + AVR32_GPIO.port[2].ovrc = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK2); + + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovrs = LEDS_LEDMASK3; + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovrc = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK3); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask, const uint32_t ActiveMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[2].ovrs = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK2); + AVR32_GPIO.port[2].ovrc = (ActiveMask & LEDS_LEDMASK2); + + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovrs = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK3); + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovrc = (ActiveMask & LEDS_LEDMASK3); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[2].ovrt = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK2); + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovrt = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK3); + } + + static inline uint32_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint32_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return ((~AVR32_GPIO.port[2].ovr & LEDS_LEDMASK2) | (~AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovr & LEDS_LEDMASK3)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/UC3A3_XPLAINED/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/UC3A3_XPLAINED/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..94abc3e49d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/UC3A3_XPLAINED/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel UC3-A3 Xplained. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_UC3_A3_XPLAINED + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_UC3_A3_XPLAINED UC3_A3_XPLAINED + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel UC3-A3 Xplained. + * + * Board specific information header for the Atmel UC3-A3 Xplained. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_UC3_A3_XPLAINED_H__ +#define __BOARD_UC3_A3_XPLAINED_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/UC3A3_XPLAINED/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/UC3A3_XPLAINED/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..879373e0ed --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/UC3A3_XPLAINED/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,109 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel UC3-A3 Xplained. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_UC3A3_XPLAINED + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_UC3A3_XPLAINED UC3A3_XPLAINED + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel UC3-A3 Xplained. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel UC3-A3 Xplained. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>SW0 Button</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO32</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_UC3A3_XPLAINED_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_UC3A3_XPLAINED_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define BUTTONS_PORT 1 + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Mask of the first button on the board */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1UL << 0) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[BUTTONS_PORT].gpers = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2); + AVR32_GPIO.port[BUTTONS_PORT].puers = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2); + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[BUTTONS_PORT].gperc = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2); + AVR32_GPIO.port[BUTTONS_PORT].puerc = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2); + } + + static inline uint32_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint32_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return (~(AVR32_GPIO.port[JOY_MOVE_PORT].pvr & (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2))); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/UC3A3_XPLAINED/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/UC3A3_XPLAINED/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cbd2bde32d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/UC3/UC3A3_XPLAINED/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,182 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel UC3-A3 Xplained. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_UC3A3_XPLAINED + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_UC3A3_XPLAINED UC3A3_XPLAINED + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel UC3-A3 Xplained. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel UC3-A3 Xplained. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Yellow</td><td>LED0 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO35</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Yellow</td><td>LED1 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO73</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Yellow</td><td>LED2 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO34</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED4</td><td>Yellow</td><td>LED3 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO38</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED5</td><td>Green</td><td>Status</td><td>Low</td><td>GPIO50</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED6</td><td>Red</td><td>Power</td><td>High</td><td>GPIO49</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_UC3A3_XPLAINED_H__ +#define __LEDS_UC3A3_XPLAINED_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define LEDS_LEDMASK1 ((1UL << 3) | (1UL << 2) | (1UL << 6) | (1UL << 18) | (1UL << 17)) + #define LEDS_LEDMASK3 (1UL << 9) + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1UL << 3) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1UL << 9) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1UL << 2) + + /** LED mask for the fourth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED4 (1UL << 6) + + /** LED mask for the fifth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED5 (1UL << 18) + + /** LED mask for the sixth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED6 (1UL << 17) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4 | LEDS_LED5 | LEDS_LED6) + + /** LED mask for the none of the board LEDs */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[1].gpers = LEDS_LEDMASK1; + AVR32_GPIO.port[1].oders = LEDS_LEDMASK1; + AVR32_GPIO.port[1].ovrs = LEDS_LEDMASK1; + + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].gpers = LEDS_LEDMASK3; + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].oders = LEDS_LEDMASK3; + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovrs = LEDS_LEDMASK3; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[1].gperc = LEDS_LEDMASK1; + AVR32_GPIO.port[1].oderc = LEDS_LEDMASK1; + AVR32_GPIO.port[1].ovrc = LEDS_LEDMASK1; + + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].gperc = LEDS_LEDMASK3; + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].oderc = LEDS_LEDMASK3; + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovrc = LEDS_LEDMASK3; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[1].ovrc = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK1); + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovrc = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK3); + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[1].ovrs = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK1); + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovrs = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK3); + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[1].ovrs = LEDS_LEDMASK1; + AVR32_GPIO.port[1].ovrc = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK1); + + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovrs = LEDS_LEDMASK3; + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovrc = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK3); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask, const uint32_t ActiveMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[1].ovrs = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK1); + AVR32_GPIO.port[1].ovrc = (ActiveMask & LEDS_LEDMASK1); + + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovrs = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK3); + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovrc = (ActiveMask & LEDS_LEDMASK3); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint32_t LEDMask) + { + AVR32_GPIO.port[1].ovrt = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK1); + AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovrt = (LEDMask & LEDS_LEDMASK3); + } + + static inline uint32_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint32_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return ((~AVR32_GPIO.port[1].ovr & LEDS_LEDMASK1) | (~AVR32_GPIO.port[3].ovr & LEDS_LEDMASK3)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2bc2377c2d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,86 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel XMEGA A3BU Xplained. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_A3BU_XPLAINED + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_A3BU_XPLAINED A3BU_XPLAINED + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel XMEGA A3BU Xplained. + * + * Board specific information header for the Atmel XMEGA A3BU Xplained. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_A3BU_XPLAINED_H__ +#define __BOARD_A3BU_XPLAINED_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../Dataflash.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Dataflash mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_DATAFLASH + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..901869d35e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,119 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel XMEGA A3BU Xplained. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_A3BU_XPLAINED + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_A3BU_XPLAINED A3BU_XPLAINED + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel XMEGA A3BU Xplained. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel XMEGA A3BU Xplained. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>SW0 Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTE.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON2</td><td>SW1 Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTF.1</td></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON3</td><td>SW2 Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTF.2</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_A3BU_XPLAINED_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_A3BU_XPLAINED_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 5) + + /** Button mask for the second button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON2 (1 << 1) + + /** Button mask for the third button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON3 (1 << 2) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + PORTE.OUTCLR = BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTE.PIN5CTRL = (PORT_OPC_PULLUP_gc | PORT_INVEN_bm); + + PORTF.OUTCLR = (BUTTONS_BUTTON2 | BUTTONS_BUTTON3); + PORTF.PIN1CTRL = (PORT_OPC_PULLUP_gc | PORT_INVEN_bm); + PORTF.PIN2CTRL = (PORT_OPC_PULLUP_gc | PORT_INVEN_bm); + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + PORTE.OUTCLR = BUTTONS_BUTTON1; + PORTE.PIN5CTRL = 0; + + PORTF.OUTCLR = (BUTTONS_BUTTON2 | BUTTONS_BUTTON3); + PORTF.PIN1CTRL = 0; + PORTF.PIN2CTRL = 0; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((PORTE_IN & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) | (PORTF_IN & (BUTTONS_BUTTON2 | BUTTONS_BUTTON3))); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/Dataflash.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/Dataflash.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b48473890b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/Dataflash.h @@ -0,0 +1,228 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Dataflash driver header for the Atmel XMEGA A3BU Xplained. + * \copydetails Group_Dataflash_A3BU_XPLAINED + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the dataflash driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Dataflash + * \defgroup Group_Dataflash_A3BU_XPLAINED A3BU_XPLAINED + * \brief Board specific Dataflash driver header for the Atmel XMEGA A3BU Xplained. + * + * Board specific Dataflash driver header for the Atmel XMEGA A3BU Xplained board. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Select Pin</th><th>SPI Port</th></tr> + * <tr><td>DATAFLASH_CHIP1</td><td>AT45DB642D (8MB)</td><td>PORTF.4</td><td>USARTD0 (In SPI Mode)</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __DATAFLASH_A3BU_XPLAINED_H__ +#define __DATAFLASH_A3BU_XPLAINED_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../../Misc/AT45DB642D.h" + #include "../../../Peripheral/SerialSPI.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_DATAFLASH_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK DATAFLASH_CHIP1 + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT PORTF + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Constant indicating the total number of dataflash ICs mounted on the selected board. */ + #define DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS 1 + + /** Mask for no dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP 0 + + /** Mask for the first dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIP1 (1 << 4) + + /** Internal main memory page size for the board's dataflash ICs. */ + #define DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE 1024 + + /** Total number of pages inside each of the board's dataflash ICs. */ + #define DATAFLASH_PAGES 8192 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initializes the dataflash driver so that commands and data may be sent to an attached dataflash IC. + * The appropriate SPI interface will be automatically configured. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_Init(void) + { + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT.DIRSET = DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK; + + PORTCFG.MPCMASK = DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK; + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT.PIN0CTRL = PORT_INVEN_bm; + + SerialSPI_Init(&USARTD0, (USART_SPI_SCK_LEAD_RISING | USART_SPI_SAMPLE_LEADING | USART_SPI_ORDER_MSB_FIRST), (F_CPU / 2)); + + PORTD.DIRSET = PIN3_bm | PIN1_bm; + PORTD.DIRCLR = PIN2_bm; + PORTC.PIN2CTRL = PORT_OPC_PULLUP_gc; + } + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns a byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + return SerialSPI_TransferByte(&USARTD0, Byte); + } + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and ignores the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + SerialSPI_SendByte(&USARTD0, Byte); + } + + /** Sends a dummy byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) + { + return SerialSPI_ReceiveByte(&USARTD0); + } + + /** Determines the currently selected dataflash chip. + * + * \return Mask of the currently selected Dataflash chip, either \ref DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP if no chip is selected + * or a DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is the chip number). + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) + { + return (DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT.OUT & DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK); + } + + /** Selects the given dataflash chip. + * + * \param[in] ChipMask Mask of the Dataflash IC to select, in the form of a \c DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is + * the chip number). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) + { + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT.OUTCLR = DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK; + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT.OUTSET = ChipMask; + } + + /** Deselects the current dataflash chip, so that no dataflash is selected. */ + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) + { + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP); + } + + /** Selects a dataflash IC from the given page number, which should range from 0 to + * ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). For boards containing only one + * dataflash IC, this will select DATAFLASH_CHIP1. If the given page number is outside + * the total number of pages contained in the boards dataflash ICs, all dataflash ICs + * are deselected. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Address of the page to manipulate, ranging from + * 0 to ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(const uint16_t PageAddress) + { + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + if (PageAddress >= (DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS)) + return; + + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + } + + /** Toggles the select line of the currently selected dataflash IC, so that it is ready to receive + * a new command. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(void) + { + uint8_t SelectedChipMask = Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(); + + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + Dataflash_SelectChip(SelectedChipMask); + } + + /** Spin-loops while the currently selected dataflash is busy executing a command, such as a main + * memory page program or main memory to buffer transfer. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(void) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + while (!(Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_READY)); + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + } + + /** Sends a set of page and buffer address bytes to the currently selected dataflash IC, for use with + * dataflash commands which require a complete 24-bit address. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Page address within the selected dataflash IC + * \param[in] BufferByte Address within the dataflash's buffer + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(uint16_t PageAddress, + const uint16_t BufferByte) + { + Dataflash_SendByte(PageAddress >> 5); + Dataflash_SendByte((PageAddress << 3) | (BufferByte >> 8)); + Dataflash_SendByte(BufferByte); + } + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a0c5b3af4b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,181 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel XMEGA A3BU Xplained. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_A3BU_XPLAINED + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_A3BU_XPLAINED A3BU_XPLAINED + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel XMEGA A3BU Xplained. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel XMEGA A3BU Xplained. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Yellow</td><td>LED0 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTR.0</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Yellow</td><td>LED1 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTR.1</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Red</td><td>Status Bicolour Red LED</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.4</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED4</td><td>Green</td><td>Status Bicolour Green LED</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.5</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_A3BU_XPLAINED_H__ +#define __LEDS_A3BU_XPLAINED_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define LEDS_PORTR_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + #define LEDS_PORTD_LEDS (LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 0) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 1) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 4) + + /** LED mask for the fourth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED4 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + PORTR.DIRSET = LEDS_PORTR_LEDS; + PORTR.OUTCLR = LEDS_PORTR_LEDS; + + PORTCFG.MPCMASK = LEDS_PORTR_LEDS; + PORTR.PIN0CTRL = PORT_INVEN_bm; + + PORTD.DIRSET = LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + PORTD.OUTCLR = LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + + PORTD.PIN4CTRL = PORT_INVEN_bm; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + PORTR.DIRCLR = LEDS_PORTR_LEDS; + PORTR.OUTCLR = LEDS_PORTR_LEDS; + + PORTCFG.MPCMASK = 0; + PORTR.PIN0CTRL = LEDS_PORTR_LEDS; + + PORTD.DIRCLR = LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + PORTD.OUTCLR = LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + + PORTD.PIN4CTRL = 0; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTR_OUTSET = LEDMask & LEDS_PORTR_LEDS; + PORTD_OUTSET = LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTR_OUTCLR = LEDMask & LEDS_PORTR_LEDS; + PORTD_OUTCLR = LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTR_OUTCLR = LEDS_PORTR_LEDS; + PORTD_OUTCLR = LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + + PORTR_OUTSET = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTR_LEDS); + PORTD_OUTSET = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTR_OUTCLR = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTR_LEDS); + PORTD_OUTCLR = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + + PORTR_OUTSET = (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTR_LEDS); + PORTD_OUTSET = (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTR_OUTTGL = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTR_LEDS); + PORTD_OUTTGL = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return ((PORTR_OUT & LEDS_PORTR_LEDS) | (PORTD_OUT & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b133b9ae3a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,86 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel XMEGA B1 Xplained. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_B1_XPLAINED + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_B1_XPLAINED B1_XPLAINED + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel XMEGA B1 Xplained. + * + * Board specific information header for the Atmel XMEGA B1 Xplained. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_B1_XPLAINED_H__ +#define __BOARD_B1_XPLAINED_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../Dataflash.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has a hardware Dataflash mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_DATAFLASH + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..01c7c084a6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,119 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel XMEGA B1 Xplained. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_B1_XPLAINED + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_B1_XPLAINED B1_XPLAINED + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel XMEGA B1 Xplained. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel XMEGA B1 Xplained. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>Touch CS0 Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTE.0</td></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON2</td><td>Touch CS1 Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTE.1</td></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON3</td><td>Touch CS2 Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTE.2</td></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON4</td><td>Touch CS3 Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTE.3</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_B1_XPLAINED_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_B1_XPLAINED_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 0) + + /** Button mask for the second button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON2 (1 << 1) + + /** Button mask for the third button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON3 (1 << 2) + + /** Button mask for the fourth button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON4 (1 << 3) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + PORTE.OUTSET = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2 | BUTTONS_BUTTON3 | BUTTONS_BUTTON4); + + PORTCFG.MPCMASK = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2 | BUTTONS_BUTTON3 | BUTTONS_BUTTON4); + PORTE.PIN0CTRL = (PORT_INVEN_bm | PORT_OPC_PULLUP_gc); + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + PORTE.OUTCLR = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2 | BUTTONS_BUTTON3 | BUTTONS_BUTTON4); + + PORTCFG.MPCMASK = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2 | BUTTONS_BUTTON3 | BUTTONS_BUTTON4); + PORTE.PIN0CTRL = 0; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return (PORTE_IN & (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2 | BUTTONS_BUTTON3 | BUTTONS_BUTTON4)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/Dataflash.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/Dataflash.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..71402661cd --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/Dataflash.h @@ -0,0 +1,229 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Dataflash driver header for the Atmel XMEGA B1 Xplained. + * \copydetails Group_Dataflash_B1_XPLAINED + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the dataflash driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Dataflash + * \defgroup Group_Dataflash_B1_XPLAINED B1_XPLAINED + * \brief Board specific Dataflash driver header for the Atmel XMEGA B1 Xplained. + * + * Board specific Dataflash driver header for the Atmel XMEGA B1 Xplained board. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Select Pin</th><th>SPI Port</th></tr> + * <tr><td>DATAFLASH_CHIP1</td><td>AT45DB642D (8MB)</td><td>PORTD.2</td><td>USARTC0 (In SPI Mode, Remapped)</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __DATAFLASH_B1_XPLAINED_H__ +#define __DATAFLASH_B1_XPLAINED_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../../Misc/AT45DB642D.h" + #include "../../../Peripheral/SerialSPI.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_DATAFLASH_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK DATAFLASH_CHIP1 + #define DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT PORTD + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Constant indicating the total number of dataflash ICs mounted on the selected board. */ + #define DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS 1 + + /** Mask for no dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP 0 + + /** Mask for the first dataflash chip selected. */ + #define DATAFLASH_CHIP1 (1 << 2) + + /** Internal main memory page size for the board's dataflash ICs. */ + #define DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE 1024 + + /** Total number of pages inside each of the board's dataflash ICs. */ + #define DATAFLASH_PAGES 8192 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initializes the dataflash driver so that commands and data may be sent to an attached dataflash IC. + * The appropriate SPI interface will be automatically configured. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_Init(void) + { + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT.DIRSET = DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK; + + PORTCFG.MPCMASK = DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK; + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT.PIN0CTRL = PORT_INVEN_bm; + + SerialSPI_Init(&USARTC0, (USART_SPI_SCK_LEAD_RISING | USART_SPI_SAMPLE_LEADING | USART_SPI_ORDER_MSB_FIRST), (F_CPU / 2)); + + PORTC.REMAP |= PORT_USART0_bm; + PORTC.DIRSET = PIN7_bm | PIN5_bm; + PORTC.DIRCLR = PIN6_bm; + PORTC.PIN6CTRL = PORT_OPC_PULLUP_gc; + } + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns a byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + return SerialSPI_TransferByte(&USARTC0, Byte); + } + + /** Sends a byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and ignores the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the dataflash + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + SerialSPI_SendByte(&USARTC0, Byte); + } + + /** Sends a dummy byte to the currently selected dataflash IC, and returns the next byte from the dataflash. + * + * \return Last response byte from the dataflash + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_ReceiveByte(void) + { + return SerialSPI_ReceiveByte(&USARTC0); + } + + /** Determines the currently selected dataflash chip. + * + * \return Mask of the currently selected Dataflash chip, either \ref DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP if no chip is selected + * or a DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is the chip number). + */ + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(void) + { + return (DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT.OUT & DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK); + } + + /** Selects the given dataflash chip. + * + * \param[in] ChipMask Mask of the Dataflash IC to select, in the form of a \c DATAFLASH_CHIPn mask (where n is + * the chip number). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChip(const uint8_t ChipMask) + { + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT.OUTCLR = DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK; + DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_PORT.OUTSET = (ChipMask & DATAFLASH_CHIPCS_MASK); + } + + /** Deselects the current dataflash chip, so that no dataflash is selected. */ + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Dataflash_DeselectChip(void) + { + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_NO_CHIP); + } + + /** Selects a dataflash IC from the given page number, which should range from 0 to + * ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). For boards containing only one + * dataflash IC, this will select DATAFLASH_CHIP1. If the given page number is outside + * the total number of pages contained in the boards dataflash ICs, all dataflash ICs + * are deselected. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Address of the page to manipulate, ranging from + * 0 to ((DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) - 1). + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(const uint16_t PageAddress) + { + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + if (PageAddress >= (DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS)) + return; + + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + } + + /** Toggles the select line of the currently selected dataflash IC, so that it is ready to receive + * a new command. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(void) + { + uint8_t SelectedChipMask = Dataflash_GetSelectedChip(); + + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + Dataflash_SelectChip(SelectedChipMask); + } + + /** Spin-loops while the currently selected dataflash is busy executing a command, such as a main + * memory page program or main memory to buffer transfer. + */ + static inline void Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(void) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + while (!(Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_READY)); + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + } + + /** Sends a set of page and buffer address bytes to the currently selected dataflash IC, for use with + * dataflash commands which require a complete 24-bit address. + * + * \param[in] PageAddress Page address within the selected dataflash IC + * \param[in] BufferByte Address within the dataflash's buffer + */ + static inline void Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(uint16_t PageAddress, + const uint16_t BufferByte) + { + Dataflash_SendByte(PageAddress >> 5); + Dataflash_SendByte((PageAddress << 3) | (BufferByte >> 8)); + Dataflash_SendByte(BufferByte); + } + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..078532ac4f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,183 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel XMEGA B1 Xplained. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_B1_XPLAINED + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_B1_XPLAINED B1_XPLAINED + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel XMEGA B1 Xplained. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel XMEGA B1 Xplained. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Yellow</td><td>LED0 LED</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.4</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Yellow</td><td>LED1 LED</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.5</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Yellow</td><td>LED2 LED</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.6</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED4</td><td>Yellow</td><td>LED3 LED</td><td>High</td><td>PORTB.7</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED5</td><td>Green</td><td>USB LED</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTE.4</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_B1_XPLAINED_H__ +#define __LEDS_B1_XPLAINED_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define LEDS_PORTB_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + #define LEDS_PORTE_LEDS LEDS_LED5 + + #define LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT 1 + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 4) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 6) + + /** LED mask for the fourth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED4 (1 << 7) + + /** LED mask for the fifth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED5 ((1 << 4) >> LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4 | LEDS_LED5) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + PORTB.DIRSET = LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + PORTB.OUTCLR = LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + + PORTCFG.MPCMASK = LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + PORTB.PIN0CTRL = PORT_INVEN_bm; + + PORTE.DIRSET = (LEDS_PORTE_LEDS << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT); + PORTE.OUTCLR = (LEDS_PORTE_LEDS << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT); + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + PORTB.DIRCLR = LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + PORTB.OUTCLR = LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + + PORTCFG.MPCMASK = 0; + PORTB.PIN0CTRL = LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + + PORTE.DIRCLR = (LEDS_PORTE_LEDS << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT); + PORTE.OUTCLR = (LEDS_PORTE_LEDS << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT); + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB_OUTSET = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTE_OUTSET = ((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT); + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB_OUTCLR = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTE_OUTCLR = ((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT); + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB_OUTCLR = LEDS_PORTB_LEDS; + PORTE_OUTCLR = (LEDS_PORTE_LEDS << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT); + + PORTB_OUTSET = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTE_OUTSET = ((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTB_OUTCLR = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTE_OUTCLR = ((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT); + + PORTB_OUTSET = (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTE_OUTSET = ((ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTB_OUTTGL = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS); + PORTE_OUTTGL = ((LEDMask & LEDS_PORTE_LEDS) << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT); + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return ((PORTB_OUT & LEDS_PORTB_LEDS) | (PORTE_OUT & (LEDS_PORTE_LEDS << LEDS_PORTE_MASK_SHIFT))); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/C3_XPLAINED/Board.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/C3_XPLAINED/Board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e48bd5836f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/C3_XPLAINED/Board.h @@ -0,0 +1,83 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel XMEGA C3 Xplained. + * \copydetails Group_BoardInfo_C3_XPLAINED + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Board driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_BoardInfo + * \defgroup Group_BoardInfo_C3_XPLAINED C3_XPLAINED + * \brief Board specific information header for the Atmel XMEGA C3 Xplained. + * + * Board specific information header for the Atmel XMEGA C3 Xplained. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BOARD_C3_XPLAINED_H__ +#define __BOARD_C3_XPLAINED_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Buttons.h" + #include "../../Dataflash.h" + #include "../../LEDs.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BOARD_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Board.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the board has hardware Buttons mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_BUTTONS + + /** Indicates the board has hardware LEDs mounted. */ + #define BOARD_HAS_LEDS + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/C3_XPLAINED/Buttons.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/C3_XPLAINED/Buttons.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1a8c1fc7e9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/C3_XPLAINED/Buttons.h @@ -0,0 +1,109 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel XMEGA C3 Xplained. + * \copydetails Group_Buttons_C3_XPLAINED + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the Buttons driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Buttons + * \defgroup Group_Buttons_C3_XPLAINED C3_XPLAINED + * \brief Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel XMEGA C3 Xplained. + * + * Board specific Buttons driver header for the Atmel XMEGA C3 Xplained. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON1</td><td>SW0 Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTF.1</td></tr> + * <tr><td>BUTTONS_BUTTON2</td><td>SW1 Button</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTF.2</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __BUTTONS_C3_XPLAINED_H__ +#define __BUTTONS_C3_XPLAINED_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_BUTTONS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Button mask for the first button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON1 (1 << 1) + + /** Button mask for the second button on the board. */ + #define BUTTONS_BUTTON2 (1 << 2) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void Buttons_Init(void) + { + PORTF.OUTCLR = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2); + PORTF.PIN1CTRL = (PORT_OPC_PULLUP_gc | PORT_INVEN_bm); + PORTF.PIN2CTRL = (PORT_OPC_PULLUP_gc | PORT_INVEN_bm); + } + + static inline void Buttons_Disable(void) + { + PORTF.OUTCLR = (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2); + PORTF.PIN1CTRL = 0; + PORTF.PIN2CTRL = 0; + } + + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Buttons_GetStatus(void) + { + return (PORTF_IN & (BUTTONS_BUTTON1 | BUTTONS_BUTTON2)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/C3_XPLAINED/LEDs.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/C3_XPLAINED/LEDs.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f701c883e1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/XMEGA/C3_XPLAINED/LEDs.h @@ -0,0 +1,181 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel XMEGA C3 Xplained. + * \copydetails Group_LEDs_C3_XPLAINED + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the LEDs driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_LEDs + * \defgroup Group_LEDs_C3_XPLAINED C3_XPLAINED + * \brief Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel XMEGA C3 Xplained. + * + * Board specific LED driver header for the Atmel XMEGA C3 Xplained. + * + * <table> + * <tr><th>Name</th><th>Color</th><th>Info</th><th>Active Level</th><th>Port Pin</th></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED1</td><td>Yellow</td><td>LED0 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTR.0</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED2</td><td>Yellow</td><td>LED1 LED</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTR.1</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED3</td><td>Red</td><td>Status Bicolour Red LED</td><td>Low</td><td>PORTD.4</td></tr> + * <tr><td>LEDS_LED4</td><td>Green</td><td>Status Bicolour Green LED</td><td>High</td><td>PORTD.5</td></tr> + * </table> + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __LEDS_C3_XPLAINED_H__ +#define __LEDS_C3_XPLAINED_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_LEDS_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDS.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define LEDS_PORTR_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + #define LEDS_PORTD_LEDS (LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the first LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED1 (1 << 0) + + /** LED mask for the second LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED2 (1 << 1) + + /** LED mask for the third LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED3 (1 << 4) + + /** LED mask for the fourth LED on the board. */ + #define LEDS_LED4 (1 << 5) + + /** LED mask for all the LEDs on the board. */ + #define LEDS_ALL_LEDS (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for none of the board LEDs. */ + #define LEDS_NO_LEDS 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + static inline void LEDs_Init(void) + { + PORTR.DIRSET = LEDS_PORTR_LEDS; + PORTR.OUTCLR = LEDS_PORTR_LEDS; + + PORTCFG.MPCMASK = LEDS_PORTR_LEDS; + PORTR.PIN0CTRL = PORT_INVEN_bm; + + PORTD.DIRSET = LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + PORTD.OUTCLR = LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + + PORTD.PIN4CTRL = PORT_INVEN_bm; + } + + static inline void LEDs_Disable(void) + { + PORTR.DIRCLR = LEDS_PORTR_LEDS; + PORTR.OUTCLR = LEDS_PORTR_LEDS; + + PORTCFG.MPCMASK = 0; + PORTR.PIN0CTRL = LEDS_PORTR_LEDS; + + PORTD.DIRCLR = LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + PORTD.OUTCLR = LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + + PORTD.PIN4CTRL = 0; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTR_OUTSET = LEDMask & LEDS_PORTR_LEDS; + PORTD_OUTSET = LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTR_OUTCLR = LEDMask & LEDS_PORTR_LEDS; + PORTD_OUTCLR = LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + } + + static inline void LEDs_SetAllLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTR_OUTCLR = LEDS_PORTR_LEDS; + PORTD_OUTCLR = LEDS_PORTD_LEDS; + + PORTR_OUTSET = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTR_LEDS); + PORTD_OUTSET = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ChangeLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask, + const uint8_t ActiveMask) + { + PORTR_OUTCLR = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTR_LEDS); + PORTD_OUTCLR = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + + PORTR_OUTSET = (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTR_LEDS); + PORTD_OUTSET = (ActiveMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + } + + static inline void LEDs_ToggleLEDs(const uint8_t LEDMask) + { + PORTR_OUTTGL = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTR_LEDS); + PORTD_OUTTGL = (LEDMask & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS); + } + + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t LEDs_GetLEDs(void) + { + return ((PORTR_OUT & LEDS_PORTR_LEDS) | (PORTD_OUT & LEDS_PORTD_LEDS)); + } + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Misc/AT45DB321C.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Misc/AT45DB321C.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e354ca47be --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Misc/AT45DB321C.h @@ -0,0 +1,100 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Command constants for the Atmel AT45DB321C Dataflash. + * \copydetails Group_AT45DB321C + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_MiscDrivers + * \defgroup Group_AT45DB321C Atmel AT45DB321C Dataflash Commands - LUFA/Drivers/Misc/AT45DB321C.h + * \brief Command constants for the Atmel AT45DB321C Dataflash. + * + * Dataflash command constants for the Atmel AT45DB321C Dataflash IC. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __AT45DB321C_CMDS_H__ +#define __AT45DB321C_CMDS_H__ + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** \name Dataflash Status Values */ + //@{ + #define DF_STATUS_READY (1 << 7) + #define DF_STATUS_COMPMISMATCH (1 << 6) + #define DF_STATUS_SECTORPROTECTION_ON (1 << 1) + //@} + + /** \name Dataflash Commands */ + //@{ + #define DF_CMD_GETSTATUS 0xD7 + + #define DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1 0x53 + #define DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF2 0x55 + #define DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1COMP 0x60 + #define DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF2COMP 0x61 + #define DF_CMD_AUTOREWRITEBUFF1 0x58 + #define DF_CMD_AUTOREWRITEBUFF2 0x59 + + #define DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD 0xD2 + #define DF_CMD_CONTARRAYREAD_LF 0xE8 + #define DF_CMD_BUFF1READ_LF 0xD4 + #define DF_CMD_BUFF2READ_LF 0xD6 + + #define DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE 0x84 + #define DF_CMD_BUFF2WRITE 0x87 + #define DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE 0x83 + #define DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE 0x86 + #define DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEM 0x88 + #define DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEM 0x89 + #define DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGETHROUGHBUFF1 0x82 + #define DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGETHROUGHBUFF2 0x85 + + #define DF_CMD_PAGEERASE 0x81 + #define DF_CMD_BLOCKERASE 0x50 + + #define DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF ((char[]){0x3D, 0x2A, 0x7F, 0xCF}) + #define DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF_BYTE1 0x3D + #define DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF_BYTE2 0x2A + #define DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF_BYTE3 0x7F + #define DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF_BYTE4 0xCF + + #define DF_CMD_READMANUFACTURERDEVICEINFO 0x9F + //@} + + /** Manufacturer code for Atmel Corporation, returned by Atmel Dataflash ICs in response to the \c DF_CMD_READMANUFACTURERDEVICEINFO command. */ + #define DF_MANUFACTURER_ATMEL 0x1F + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Misc/AT45DB642D.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Misc/AT45DB642D.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..76a7a5cb6c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Misc/AT45DB642D.h @@ -0,0 +1,116 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Command constants for the Atmel AT45DB642D Dataflash. + * \copydetails Group_AT45DB642D + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_MiscDrivers + * \defgroup Group_AT45DB642D Atmel AT45DB642D Dataflash Commands - LUFA/Drivers/Misc/AT45DB642D.h + * \brief Command constants for the Atmel AT45DB642D Dataflash. + * + * Dataflash command constants for the Atmel AT45DB642D Dataflash IC. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __AT45DB642D_CMDS_H__ +#define __AT45DB642D_CMDS_H__ + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** \name Dataflash Status Values */ + //@{ + #define DF_STATUS_READY (1 << 7) + #define DF_STATUS_COMPMISMATCH (1 << 6) + #define DF_STATUS_SECTORPROTECTION_ON (1 << 1) + #define DF_STATUS_BINARYPAGESIZE_ON (1 << 0) + //@} + + /** \name Dataflash Commands */ + //@{ + #define DF_CMD_GETSTATUS 0xD7 + #define DF_CMD_POWERDOWN 0xB9 + #define DF_CMD_WAKEUP 0xAB + + #define DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1 0x53 + #define DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF2 0x55 + #define DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1COMP 0x60 + #define DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF2COMP 0x61 + #define DF_CMD_AUTOREWRITEBUFF1 0x58 + #define DF_CMD_AUTOREWRITEBUFF2 0x59 + + #define DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD 0xD2 + #define DF_CMD_CONTARRAYREAD_LF 0x03 + #define DF_CMD_BUFF1READ_LF 0xD1 + #define DF_CMD_BUFF2READ_LF 0xD3 + + #define DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE 0x84 + #define DF_CMD_BUFF2WRITE 0x87 + #define DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE 0x83 + #define DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE 0x86 + #define DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEM 0x88 + #define DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEM 0x89 + #define DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGETHROUGHBUFF1 0x82 + #define DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGETHROUGHBUFF2 0x85 + + #define DF_CMD_PAGEERASE 0x81 + #define DF_CMD_BLOCKERASE 0x50 + #define DF_CMD_SECTORERASE 0x7C + + #define DF_CMD_CHIPERASE ((char[]){0xC7, 0x94, 0x80, 0x9A}) + #define DF_CMD_CHIPERASE_BYTE1 0xC7 + #define DF_CMD_CHIPERASE_BYTE2 0x94 + #define DF_CMD_CHIPERASE_BYTE3 0x80 + #define DF_CMD_CHIPERASE_BYTE4 0x9A + + #define DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF ((char[]){0x3D, 0x2A, 0x7F, 0x9A}) + #define DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF_BYTE1 0x3D + #define DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF_BYTE2 0x2A + #define DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF_BYTE3 0x7F + #define DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF_BYTE4 0x9A + + #define DF_CMD_BINARYPAGESIZEMODEON ((char[]){0x3D, 0x2A, 0x80, 0xA6}) + #define DF_CMD_BINARYPAGESIZEMODEON_BYTE1 0x3D + #define DF_CMD_BINARYPAGESIZEMODEON_BYTE2 0x2A + #define DF_CMD_BINARYPAGESIZEMODEON_BYTE3 0x80 + #define DF_CMD_BINARYPAGESIZEMODEON_BYTE4 0xA6 + + #define DF_CMD_READMANUFACTURERDEVICEINFO 0x9F + //@} + + /** Manufacturer code for Atmel Corporation, returned by Atmel Dataflash ICs in response to the \c DF_CMD_READMANUFACTURERDEVICEINFO command. */ + #define DF_MANUFACTURER_ATMEL 0x1F + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Misc/RingBuffer.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Misc/RingBuffer.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0e76a0779a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Misc/RingBuffer.h @@ -0,0 +1,308 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Lightweight ring (circular) buffer, for fast insertion/deletion of bytes. + * + * Lightweight ring buffer, for fast insertion/deletion. Multiple buffers can be created of + * different sizes to suit different needs. + * + * Note that for each buffer, insertion and removal operations may occur at the same time (via + * a multi-threaded ISR based system) however the same kind of operation (two or more insertions + * or deletions) must not overlap. If there is possibility of two or more of the same kind of + * operating occurring at the same point in time, atomic (mutex) locking should be used. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_MiscDrivers + * \defgroup Group_RingBuff Generic Byte Ring Buffer - LUFA/Drivers/Misc/RingBuffer.h + * \brief Lightweight ring buffer, for fast insertion/deletion of bytes. + * + * \section Sec_RingBuff_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - None + * + * \section Sec_RingBuff_ModDescription Module Description + * Lightweight ring buffer, for fast insertion/deletion. Multiple buffers can be created of + * different sizes to suit different needs. + * + * Note that for each buffer, insertion and removal operations may occur at the same time (via + * a multi-threaded ISR based system) however the same kind of operation (two or more insertions + * or deletions) must not overlap. If there is possibility of two or more of the same kind of + * operating occurring at the same point in time, atomic (mutex) locking should be used. + * + * \section Sec_RingBuff_ExampleUsage Example Usage + * The following snippet is an example of how this module may be used within a typical + * application. + * + * \code + * // Create the buffer structure and its underlying storage array + * RingBuffer_t Buffer; + * uint8_t BufferData[128]; + * + * // Initialize the buffer with the created storage array + * RingBuffer_InitBuffer(&Buffer, BufferData, sizeof(BufferData)); + * + * // Insert some data into the buffer + * RingBuffer_Insert(&Buffer, 'H'); + * RingBuffer_Insert(&Buffer, 'E'); + * RingBuffer_Insert(&Buffer, 'L'); + * RingBuffer_Insert(&Buffer, 'L'); + * RingBuffer_Insert(&Buffer, 'O'); + * + * // Cache the number of stored bytes in the buffer + * uint16_t BufferCount = RingBuffer_GetCount(&Buffer); + * + * // Printer stored data length + * printf("Buffer Length: %d, Buffer Data: \r\n", BufferCount); + * + * // Print contents of the buffer one character at a time + * while (BufferCount--) + * putc(RingBuffer_Remove(&Buffer)); + * \endcode + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __RING_BUFFER_H__ +#define __RING_BUFFER_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief Ring Buffer Management Structure. + * + * Type define for a new ring buffer object. Buffers should be initialized via a call to + * \ref RingBuffer_InitBuffer() before use. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t* In; /**< Current storage location in the circular buffer. */ + uint8_t* Out; /**< Current retrieval location in the circular buffer. */ + uint8_t* Start; /**< Pointer to the start of the buffer's underlying storage array. */ + uint8_t* End; /**< Pointer to the end of the buffer's underlying storage array. */ + uint16_t Size; /**< Size of the buffer's underlying storage array. */ + uint16_t Count; /**< Number of bytes currently stored in the buffer. */ + } RingBuffer_t; + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initializes a ring buffer ready for use. Buffers must be initialized via this function + * before any operations are called upon them. Already initialized buffers may be reset + * by re-initializing them using this function. + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to a ring buffer structure to initialize. + * \param[out] DataPtr Pointer to a global array that will hold the data stored into the ring buffer. + * \param[out] Size Maximum number of bytes that can be stored in the underlying data array. + */ + static inline void RingBuffer_InitBuffer(RingBuffer_t* Buffer, + uint8_t* const DataPtr, + const uint16_t Size) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + static inline void RingBuffer_InitBuffer(RingBuffer_t* Buffer, + uint8_t* const DataPtr, + const uint16_t Size) + { + GCC_FORCE_POINTER_ACCESS(Buffer); + + uint_reg_t CurrentGlobalInt = GetGlobalInterruptMask(); + GlobalInterruptDisable(); + + Buffer->In = DataPtr; + Buffer->Out = DataPtr; + Buffer->Start = &DataPtr[0]; + Buffer->End = &DataPtr[Size]; + Buffer->Size = Size; + Buffer->Count = 0; + + SetGlobalInterruptMask(CurrentGlobalInt); + } + + /** Retrieves the current number of bytes stored in a particular buffer. This value is computed + * by entering an atomic lock on the buffer, so that the buffer cannot be modified while the + * computation takes place. This value should be cached when reading out the contents of the buffer, + * so that as small a time as possible is spent in an atomic lock. + * + * \note The value returned by this function is guaranteed to only be the minimum number of bytes + * stored in the given buffer; this value may change as other threads write new data, thus + * the returned number should be used only to determine how many successive reads may safely + * be performed on the buffer. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to a ring buffer structure whose count is to be computed. + * + * \return Number of bytes currently stored in the buffer. + */ + static inline uint16_t RingBuffer_GetCount(RingBuffer_t* const Buffer) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline uint16_t RingBuffer_GetCount(RingBuffer_t* const Buffer) + { + uint16_t Count; + + uint_reg_t CurrentGlobalInt = GetGlobalInterruptMask(); + GlobalInterruptDisable(); + + Count = Buffer->Count; + + SetGlobalInterruptMask(CurrentGlobalInt); + return Count; + } + + /** Retrieves the free space in a particular buffer. This value is computed by entering an atomic lock + * on the buffer, so that the buffer cannot be modified while the computation takes place. + * + * \note The value returned by this function is guaranteed to only be the maximum number of bytes + * free in the given buffer; this value may change as other threads write new data, thus + * the returned number should be used only to determine how many successive writes may safely + * be performed on the buffer when there is a single writer thread. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to a ring buffer structure whose free count is to be computed. + * + * \return Number of free bytes in the buffer. + */ + static inline uint16_t RingBuffer_GetFreeCount(RingBuffer_t* const Buffer) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline uint16_t RingBuffer_GetFreeCount(RingBuffer_t* const Buffer) + { + return (Buffer->Size - RingBuffer_GetCount(Buffer)); + } + + /** Atomically determines if the specified ring buffer contains any data. This should + * be tested before removing data from the buffer, to ensure that the buffer does not + * underflow. + * + * If the data is to be removed in a loop, store the total number of bytes stored in the + * buffer (via a call to the \ref RingBuffer_GetCount() function) in a temporary variable + * to reduce the time spent in atomicity locks. + * + * \param[in,out] Buffer Pointer to a ring buffer structure to insert into. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the buffer contains no free space, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool RingBuffer_IsEmpty(RingBuffer_t* const Buffer) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline bool RingBuffer_IsEmpty(RingBuffer_t* const Buffer) + { + return (RingBuffer_GetCount(Buffer) == 0); + } + + /** Atomically determines if the specified ring buffer contains any free space. This should + * be tested before storing data to the buffer, to ensure that no data is lost due to a + * buffer overrun. + * + * \param[in,out] Buffer Pointer to a ring buffer structure to insert into. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the buffer contains no free space, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool RingBuffer_IsFull(RingBuffer_t* const Buffer) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline bool RingBuffer_IsFull(RingBuffer_t* const Buffer) + { + return (RingBuffer_GetCount(Buffer) == Buffer->Size); + } + + /** Inserts an element into the ring buffer. + * + * \warning Only one execution thread (main program thread or an ISR) may insert into a single buffer + * otherwise data corruption may occur. Insertion and removal may occur from different execution + * threads. + * + * \param[in,out] Buffer Pointer to a ring buffer structure to insert into. + * \param[in] Data Data element to insert into the buffer. + */ + static inline void RingBuffer_Insert(RingBuffer_t* Buffer, + const uint8_t Data) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void RingBuffer_Insert(RingBuffer_t* Buffer, + const uint8_t Data) + { + GCC_FORCE_POINTER_ACCESS(Buffer); + + *Buffer->In = Data; + + if (++Buffer->In == Buffer->End) + Buffer->In = Buffer->Start; + + uint_reg_t CurrentGlobalInt = GetGlobalInterruptMask(); + GlobalInterruptDisable(); + + Buffer->Count++; + + SetGlobalInterruptMask(CurrentGlobalInt); + } + + /** Removes an element from the ring buffer. + * + * \warning Only one execution thread (main program thread or an ISR) may remove from a single buffer + * otherwise data corruption may occur. Insertion and removal may occur from different execution + * threads. + * + * \param[in,out] Buffer Pointer to a ring buffer structure to retrieve from. + * + * \return Next data element stored in the buffer. + */ + static inline uint8_t RingBuffer_Remove(RingBuffer_t* Buffer) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline uint8_t RingBuffer_Remove(RingBuffer_t* Buffer) + { + GCC_FORCE_POINTER_ACCESS(Buffer); + + uint8_t Data = *Buffer->Out; + + if (++Buffer->Out == Buffer->End) + Buffer->Out = Buffer->Start; + + uint_reg_t CurrentGlobalInt = GetGlobalInterruptMask(); + GlobalInterruptDisable(); + + Buffer->Count--; + + SetGlobalInterruptMask(CurrentGlobalInt); + + return Data; + } + + /** Returns the next element stored in the ring buffer, without removing it. + * + * \param[in,out] Buffer Pointer to a ring buffer structure to retrieve from. + * + * \return Next data element stored in the buffer. + */ + static inline uint8_t RingBuffer_Peek(RingBuffer_t* const Buffer) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline uint8_t RingBuffer_Peek(RingBuffer_t* const Buffer) + { + return *Buffer->Out; + } + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b12a247ed1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h @@ -0,0 +1,231 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief ANSI terminal special escape code macros. + * + * ANSI terminal compatible escape sequences. These escape sequences are designed to be concatenated with existing + * strings to modify their display on a compatible terminal application. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_MiscDrivers + * \defgroup Group_Terminal ANSI Terminal Escape Codes - LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h + * \brief ANSI terminal special escape code macros. + * + * \section Sec_Terminal_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - None + * + * \section Sec_Terminal_ModDescription Module Description + * Escape code macros for ANSI compliant text terminals. + * + * \note If desired, the macro \c DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES can be defined in the project makefile and passed to the GCC + * compiler via the -D switch to disable the terminal codes without modifying the source, for use with non + * compatible terminals (any terminal codes then equate to empty strings). + * + * \section Sec_Terminal_ExampleUsage Example Usage + * The following snippet is an example of how this module may be used within a typical + * application. + * + * \code + * printf("Normal String, " + * ESC_BOLD_ON "Bold String, " + * ESC_UNDERLINE_ON "Bold and Underlined String" + * ESC_RESET ESC_FG_BLUE ESC_BG_YELLOW "Normal Blue-on-Yellow String"); + * \endcode + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __TERMINALCODES_H__ +#define __TERMINALCODES_H__ + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + #if !defined(DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES) + /** Creates an ANSI escape sequence with the specified payload. + * + * \param[in] EscapeSeq Payload to encode as an ANSI escape sequence, a \c ESC_* mask. + */ + #define ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE(EscapeSeq) "\33[" EscapeSeq + #else + #define ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE(EscapeSeq) + #endif + + /** \name Text Display Modifier Control Sequences */ + //@{ + /** Turns on bold so that any following text is printed to the terminal in bold. */ + #define ESC_BOLD_ON ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("1m") + + /** Turns on italics so that any following text is printed to the terminal in italics. */ + #define ESC_ITALICS_ON ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("3m") + + /** Turns on underline so that any following text is printed to the terminal underlined. */ + #define ESC_UNDERLINE_ON ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("4m") + + /** Turns on inverse so that any following text is printed to the terminal in inverted colours. */ + #define ESC_INVERSE_ON ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("7m") + + /** Turns on strike-through so that any following text is printed to the terminal with a line through the + * center. + */ + #define ESC_STRIKETHROUGH_ON ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("9m") + + /** Turns off bold so that any following text is printed to the terminal in non bold. */ + #define ESC_BOLD_OFF ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("22m") + + /** Turns off italics so that any following text is printed to the terminal in non italics. */ + #define ESC_ITALICS_OFF ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("23m") + + /** Turns off underline so that any following text is printed to the terminal non underlined. */ + #define ESC_UNDERLINE_OFF ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("24m") + + /** Turns off inverse so that any following text is printed to the terminal in non inverted colours. */ + #define ESC_INVERSE_OFF ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("27m") + + /** Turns off strike-through so that any following text is printed to the terminal without a line through + * the center. + */ + #define ESC_STRIKETHROUGH_OFF ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("29m") + //@} + + /** \name Text Colour Control Sequences */ + //@{ + /** Sets the foreground (text) colour to black. */ + #define ESC_FG_BLACK ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("30m") + + /** Sets the foreground (text) colour to red. */ + #define ESC_FG_RED ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("31m") + + /** Sets the foreground (text) colour to green. */ + #define ESC_FG_GREEN ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("32m") + + /** Sets the foreground (text) colour to yellow. */ + #define ESC_FG_YELLOW ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("33m") + + /** Sets the foreground (text) colour to blue. */ + #define ESC_FG_BLUE ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("34m") + + /** Sets the foreground (text) colour to magenta. */ + #define ESC_FG_MAGENTA ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("35m") + + /** Sets the foreground (text) colour to cyan. */ + #define ESC_FG_CYAN ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("36m") + + /** Sets the foreground (text) colour to white. */ + #define ESC_FG_WHITE ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("37m") + + /** Sets the foreground (text) colour to the terminal's default. */ + #define ESC_FG_DEFAULT ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("39m") + + /** Sets the text background colour to black. */ + #define ESC_BG_BLACK ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("40m") + + /** Sets the text background colour to red. */ + #define ESC_BG_RED ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("41m") + + /** Sets the text background colour to green. */ + #define ESC_BG_GREEN ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("42m") + + /** Sets the text background colour to yellow. */ + #define ESC_BG_YELLOW ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("43m") + + /** Sets the text background colour to blue. */ + #define ESC_BG_BLUE ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("44m") + + /** Sets the text background colour to magenta. */ + #define ESC_BG_MAGENTA ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("45m") + + /** Sets the text background colour to cyan. */ + #define ESC_BG_CYAN ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("46m") + + /** Sets the text background colour to white. */ + #define ESC_BG_WHITE ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("47m") + + /** Sets the text background colour to the terminal's default. */ + #define ESC_BG_DEFAULT ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("49m") + //@} + + /** \name Cursor Positioning Control Sequences */ + //@{ + /** Saves the current cursor position so that it may be restored with \ref ESC_CURSOR_POS_RESTORE. */ + #define ESC_CURSOR_POS_SAVE ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("s") + + /** Restores the cursor position to the last position saved with \ref ESC_CURSOR_POS_SAVE. */ + #define ESC_CURSOR_POS_RESTORE ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("u") + + /** Sets the cursor position to the given line and column. + * + * \param[in] Line Line number to position the cursor at. + * \param[in] Column Column number to position the cursor at. + */ + #define ESC_CURSOR_POS(Line, Column) ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE(#Line ";" #Column "H") + + /** Moves the cursor up the given number of lines. + * + * \param[in] Lines Number of lines to move the cursor position + */ + #define ESC_CURSOR_UP(Lines) ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE(#Lines "A") + + /** Moves the cursor down the given number of lines. + * + * \param[in] Lines Number of lines to move the cursor position + */ + #define ESC_CURSOR_DOWN(Lines) ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE(#Lines "B") + + /** Moves the cursor to the right the given number of columns. + * + * \param[in] Columns Number of columns to move the cursor position + */ + #define ESC_CURSOR_FORWARD(Columns) ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE(#Columns "C") + + /** Moves the cursor to the left the given number of columns. + * + * \param[in] Columns Number of columns to move the cursor position + */ + #define ESC_CURSOR_BACKWARD(Columns) ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE(#Columns "D") + //@} + + /** \name Miscellaneous Control Sequences */ + //@{ + /** Resets any escape sequence modifiers back to their defaults. */ + #define ESC_RESET ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("0m") + + /** Erases the entire display, returning the cursor to the top left. */ + #define ESC_ERASE_DISPLAY ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("2J") + + /** Erases the current line, returning the cursor to the far left. */ + #define ESC_ERASE_LINE ANSI_ESCAPE_SEQUENCE("K") + //@} + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/ADC.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/ADC.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a0182b3c77 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/ADC.h @@ -0,0 +1,75 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Hardware Analogue-to-Digital converter driver. + * + * This file is the master dispatch header file for the device-specific ADC driver, for microcontrollers + * containing an ADC. + * + * User code should include this file, which will in turn include the correct ADC driver header file for the + * currently selected architecture and microcontroller model. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PeripheralDrivers + * \defgroup Group_ADC ADC Driver - LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/ADC.h + * \brief Hardware Analogue-to-Digital converter driver. + * + * \section Sec_ADC_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - None + * + * \section Sec_ADC_ModDescription Module Description + * Hardware ADC driver. This module provides an easy to use driver for the hardware ADC + * present on many microcontrollers, for the conversion of analogue signals into the + * digital domain. + * + * \note The exact API for this driver may vary depending on the target used - see + * individual target module documentation for the API specific to your target processor. + */ + +#ifndef __ADC_H__ +#define __ADC_H__ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_ADC_H + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Includes: */ + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + #include "AVR8/ADC_AVR8.h" + #else + #error The ADC peripheral driver is not currently available for your selected architecture. + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/ADC_AVR8.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/ADC_AVR8.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a2b7eded3d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/ADC_AVR8.h @@ -0,0 +1,446 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief ADC Peripheral Driver (AVR8) + * + * On-chip Analogue-to-Digital converter (ADC) driver for supported U4, U6 and U7 model AVRs that contain an ADC + * peripheral internally. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the ADC driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/ADC.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_ADC + * \defgroup Group_ADC_AVR8 ADC Peripheral Driver (AVR8) + * + * \section Sec_ADC_AVR8_ModDescription Module Description + * On-chip Analogue-to-Digital converter (ADC) driver for supported U4, U6 and U7 model AVRs that contain an ADC + * peripheral internally. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the ADC driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/ADC.h. + * + * \section Sec_ADC_AVR8_ExampleUsage Example Usage + * The following snippet is an example of how this module may be used within a typical + * application. + * + * \code + * // Initialize the ADC driver before first use + * ADC_Init(ADC_FREE_RUNNING | ADC_PRESCALE_32); + * + * // Must setup the ADC channel to read beforehand + * ADC_SetupChannel(1); + * + * // Perform a single conversion of the ADC channel 1 + * ADC_GetChannelReading(ADC_REFERENCE_AVCC | ADC_RIGHT_ADJUSTED | ADC_CHANNEL1); + * printf("Conversion Result: %d\r\n", ADC_GetResult()); + * + * // Start reading ADC channel 1 in free running (continuous conversion) mode + * ADC_StartReading(ADC_REFERENCE_AVCC | ADC_RIGHT_ADJUSTED | ADC_CHANNEL1); + * for (;;) + * { + * while (!(ADC_IsReadingComplete())) {}; + * printf("Conversion Result: %d\r\n", ADC_GetResult()); + * } + * \endcode + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __ADC_AVR8_H__ +#define __ADC_AVR8_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_ADC_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/ADC.h instead. + #endif + + #if !(defined(__AVR_AT90USB1286__) || defined(__AVR_AT90USB646__) || \ + defined(__AVR_AT90USB1287__) || defined(__AVR_AT90USB647__) || \ + defined(__AVR_ATmega16U4__) || defined(__AVR_ATmega32U4__)) + #error The ADC peripheral driver is not currently available for your selected microcontroller model. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** \name ADC Reference Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** Reference mask, for using the voltage present at the AVR's AREF pin for the ADC reference. */ + #define ADC_REFERENCE_AREF 0 + + /** Reference mask, for using the voltage present at the AVR's AVCC pin for the ADC reference. */ + #define ADC_REFERENCE_AVCC (1 << REFS0) + + /** Reference mask, for using the internally generated 2.56V reference voltage as the ADC reference. */ + #define ADC_REFERENCE_INT2560MV ((1 << REFS1) | (1 << REFS0)) + //@} + + /** \name ADC Result Adjustment Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** Left-adjusts the 10-bit ADC result, so that the upper 8 bits of the value returned by the + * \ref ADC_GetResult() macro contain the 8 most significant bits of the result. + */ + #define ADC_LEFT_ADJUSTED (1 << ADLAR) + + /** Right-adjusts the 10-bit ADC result, so that the lower 8 bits of the value returned by the + * \ref ADC_GetResult() macro contain the 8 least significant bits of the result. + */ + #define ADC_RIGHT_ADJUSTED (0 << ADLAR) + //@} + + /** \name ADC Mode Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** Sets the ADC mode to free running, so that conversions take place continuously as fast as the ADC + * is capable of at the given input clock speed. + */ + #define ADC_FREE_RUNNING (1 << ADATE) + + /** Sets the ADC mode to single conversion, so that only a single conversion will take place before + * the ADC returns to idle. + */ + #define ADC_SINGLE_CONVERSION (0 << ADATE) + //@} + + /** \name ADC Prescaler Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** Sets the ADC input clock to prescale by a factor of 2 the AVR's system clock. */ + #define ADC_PRESCALE_2 (1 << ADPS0) + + /** Sets the ADC input clock to prescale by a factor of 4 the AVR's system clock. */ + #define ADC_PRESCALE_4 (1 << ADPS1) + + /** Sets the ADC input clock to prescale by a factor of 8 the AVR's system clock. */ + #define ADC_PRESCALE_8 ((1 << ADPS0) | (1 << ADPS1)) + + /** Sets the ADC input clock to prescale by a factor of 16 the AVR's system clock. */ + #define ADC_PRESCALE_16 (1 << ADPS2) + + /** Sets the ADC input clock to prescale by a factor of 32 the AVR's system clock. */ + #define ADC_PRESCALE_32 ((1 << ADPS2) | (1 << ADPS0)) + + /** Sets the ADC input clock to prescale by a factor of 64 the AVR's system clock. */ + #define ADC_PRESCALE_64 ((1 << ADPS2) | (1 << ADPS1)) + + /** Sets the ADC input clock to prescale by a factor of 128 the AVR's system clock. */ + #define ADC_PRESCALE_128 ((1 << ADPS2) | (1 << ADPS1) | (1 << ADPS0)) + //@} + + /** \name ADC MUX Masks */ + //@{ + /** MUX mask define for the ADC0 channel of the ADC. See \ref ADC_StartReading() and \ref ADC_GetChannelReading(). */ + #define ADC_CHANNEL0 (0x00 << MUX0) + + /** MUX mask define for the ADC1 channel of the ADC. See \ref ADC_StartReading() and \ref ADC_GetChannelReading(). */ + #define ADC_CHANNEL1 (0x01 << MUX0) + + #if (!(defined(__AVR_ATmega16U4__) || defined(__AVR_ATmega32U4__)) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + /** MUX mask define for the ADC2 channel of the ADC. See \ref ADC_StartReading() and \ref ADC_GetChannelReading(). + * + * \note Not available on all AVR models. + */ + #define ADC_CHANNEL2 (0x02 << MUX0) + + /** MUX mask define for the ADC3 channel of the ADC. See \ref ADC_StartReading() and \ref ADC_GetChannelReading(). + * + * \note Not available on all AVR models. + */ + #define ADC_CHANNEL3 (0x03 << MUX0) + #endif + + /** MUX mask define for the ADC4 channel of the ADC. See \ref ADC_StartReading() and \ref ADC_GetChannelReading(). */ + #define ADC_CHANNEL4 (0x04 << MUX0) + + /** MUX mask define for the ADC5 channel of the ADC. See \ref ADC_StartReading() and \ref ADC_GetChannelReading(). */ + #define ADC_CHANNEL5 (0x05 << MUX0) + + /** MUX mask define for the ADC6 channel of the ADC. See \ref ADC_StartReading() and \ref ADC_GetChannelReading(). */ + #define ADC_CHANNEL6 (0x06 << MUX0) + + /** MUX mask define for the ADC7 channel of the ADC. See \ref ADC_StartReading and \ref ADC_GetChannelReading. */ + #define ADC_CHANNEL7 (0x07 << MUX0) + + #if (defined(__AVR_ATmega16U4__) || defined(__AVR_ATmega32U4__) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + /** MUX mask define for the ADC8 channel of the ADC. See \ref ADC_StartReading() and \ref ADC_GetChannelReading(). + * + * \note Not available on all AVR models. + */ + #define ADC_CHANNEL8 ((1 << 8) | (0x00 << MUX0)) + + /** MUX mask define for the ADC9 channel of the ADC. See \ref ADC_StartReading() and \ref ADC_GetChannelReading(). + * + * \note Not available on all AVR models. + */ + #define ADC_CHANNEL9 ((1 << 8) | (0x01 << MUX0)) + + /** MUX mask define for the ADC10 channel of the ADC. See \ref ADC_StartReading() and \ref ADC_GetChannelReading(). + * + * \note Not available on all AVR models. + */ + #define ADC_CHANNEL10 ((1 << 8) | (0x02 << MUX0)) + + /** MUX mask define for the ADC11 channel of the ADC. See \ref ADC_StartReading() and \ref ADC_GetChannelReading(). + * + * \note Not available on all AVR models. + */ + #define ADC_CHANNEL11 ((1 << 8) | (0x03 << MUX0)) + + /** MUX mask define for the ADC12 channel of the ADC. See \ref ADC_StartReading() and \ref ADC_GetChannelReading(). + * + * \note Not available on all AVR models. + */ + #define ADC_CHANNEL12 ((1 << 8) | (0x04 << MUX0)) + + /** MUX mask define for the ADC13 channel of the ADC. See \ref ADC_StartReading() and \ref ADC_GetChannelReading(). + * + * \note Not available on all AVR models. + */ + #define ADC_CHANNEL13 ((1 << 8) | (0x05 << MUX0)) + + /** MUX mask define for the internal temperature sensor channel of the ADC. See \ref ADC_StartReading() and + * \ref ADC_GetChannelReading(). + * + * \note Not available on all AVR models. + */ + #define ADC_INT_TEMP_SENS ((1 << 8) | (0x07 << MUX0)) + #endif + + /** MUX mask define for the internal 1.1V band-gap channel of the ADC. See \ref ADC_StartReading() and \ref ADC_GetChannelReading(). */ + #define ADC_1100MV_BANDGAP (0x1E << MUX0) + + /** Retrieves the ADC MUX mask for the given ADC channel number. + * + * \attention This macro will only work correctly on channel numbers that are compile-time + * constants defined by the preprocessor. + * + * \param[in] Channel Index of the ADC channel whose MUX mask is to be retrieved. + */ + #define ADC_GET_CHANNEL_MASK(Channel) CONCAT_EXPANDED(ADC_CHANNEL, Channel) + //@} + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Configures the given ADC channel, ready for ADC conversions. This function sets the + * associated port pin as an input and disables the digital portion of the I/O to reduce + * power consumption. + * + * \note This must only be called for ADC channels with are connected to a physical port + * pin of the AVR, denoted by its special alternative function ADCx. + * + * \warning The channel number must be specified as an integer, and <b>not</b> a \c ADC_CHANNEL* mask. + * + * \param[in] ChannelIndex ADC channel number to set up for conversions. + */ + static inline void ADC_SetupChannel(const uint8_t ChannelIndex) + { + #if (defined(__AVR_AT90USB1286__) || defined(__AVR_AT90USB646__) || \ + defined(__AVR_AT90USB1287__) || defined(__AVR_AT90USB647__)) + DDRF &= ~(1 << ChannelIndex); + DIDR0 |= (1 << ChannelIndex); + #elif (defined(__AVR_ATmega16U4__) || defined(__AVR_ATmega32U4__)) + if (ChannelIndex < 8) + { + DDRF &= ~(1 << ChannelIndex); + DIDR0 |= (1 << ChannelIndex); + } + else if (ChannelIndex == 8) + { + DDRD &= ~(1 << 4); + DIDR2 |= (1 << 0); + } + else if (ChannelIndex < 11) + { + DDRD &= ~(1 << (ChannelIndex - 3)); + DIDR2 |= (1 << (ChannelIndex - 8)); + } + else + { + DDRB &= ~(1 << (ChannelIndex - 7)); + DIDR2 |= (1 << (ChannelIndex - 8)); + } + #endif + } + + /** De-configures the given ADC channel, re-enabling digital I/O mode instead of analog. This + * function sets the associated port pin as an input and re-enabled the digital portion of + * the I/O. + * + * \note This must only be called for ADC channels with are connected to a physical port + * pin of the AVR, denoted by its special alternative function ADCx. + * + * \warning The channel number must be specified as an integer, and <b>not</b> a \c ADC_CHANNEL* mask. + * + * \param[in] ChannelIndex ADC channel number to set up for conversions. + */ + static inline void ADC_DisableChannel(const uint8_t ChannelIndex) + { + #if (defined(__AVR_AT90USB1286__) || defined(__AVR_AT90USB646__) || \ + defined(__AVR_AT90USB1287__) || defined(__AVR_AT90USB647__)) + DDRF &= ~(1 << ChannelIndex); + DIDR0 &= ~(1 << ChannelIndex); + #elif (defined(__AVR_ATmega16U4__) || defined(__AVR_ATmega32U4__)) + if (ChannelIndex < 8) + { + DDRF &= ~(1 << ChannelIndex); + DIDR0 &= ~(1 << ChannelIndex); + } + else if (ChannelIndex == 8) + { + DDRD &= ~(1 << 4); + DIDR2 &= ~(1 << 0); + } + else if (ChannelIndex < 11) + { + DDRD &= ~(1 << (ChannelIndex - 3)); + DIDR2 &= ~(1 << (ChannelIndex - 8)); + } + else + { + DDRB &= ~(1 << (ChannelIndex - 7)); + DIDR2 &= ~(1 << (ChannelIndex - 8)); + } + #endif + } + + /** Starts the reading of the given channel, but does not wait until the conversion has completed. + * Once executed, the conversion status can be determined via the \ref ADC_IsReadingComplete() macro and + * the result read via the \ref ADC_GetResult() macro. + * + * If the ADC has been initialized in free running mode, calling this function once will begin the repeated + * conversions. If the ADC is in single conversion mode (or the channel to convert from is to be changed), + * this function must be called each time a conversion is to take place. + * + * \param[in] MUXMask ADC channel mask, reference mask and adjustment mask. + */ + static inline void ADC_StartReading(const uint16_t MUXMask) + { + ADMUX = MUXMask; + + #if (defined(__AVR_ATmega16U4__) || defined(__AVR_ATmega32U4__) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + if (MUXMask & (1 << 8)) + ADCSRB |= (1 << MUX5); + else + ADCSRB &= ~(1 << MUX5); + #endif + + ADCSRA |= (1 << ADSC); + } + + /** Indicates if the current ADC conversion is completed, or still in progress. + * + * \return Boolean \c false if the reading is still taking place, or true if the conversion is + * complete and ready to be read out with \ref ADC_GetResult(). + */ + static inline bool ADC_IsReadingComplete(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool ADC_IsReadingComplete(void) + { + return ((ADCSRA & (1 << ADIF)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Retrieves the conversion value of the last completed ADC conversion and clears the reading + * completion flag. + * + * \return The result of the last ADC conversion as an unsigned value. + */ + static inline uint16_t ADC_GetResult(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint16_t ADC_GetResult(void) + { + ADCSRA |= (1 << ADIF); + return ADC; + } + + /** Performs a complete single reading from channel, including a polling spin-loop to wait for the + * conversion to complete, and the returning of the converted value. + * + * \note For free running mode, the automated conversions should be initialized with a single call + * to \ref ADC_StartReading() to select the channel and begin the automated conversions, and + * the results read directly from the \ref ADC_GetResult() instead to reduce overhead. + * + * \param[in] MUXMask Mask comprising of an ADC channel mask, reference mask and adjustment mask. + * + * \return Converted ADC result for the given ADC channel. + */ + static inline uint16_t ADC_GetChannelReading(const uint16_t MUXMask) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint16_t ADC_GetChannelReading(const uint16_t MUXMask) + { + ADC_StartReading(MUXMask); + + while (!(ADC_IsReadingComplete())); + + return ADC_GetResult(); + } + + /** Initializes the ADC, ready for conversions. This must be called before any other ADC operations. + * The "mode" parameter should be a mask comprised of a conversion mode (free running or single) and + * prescaler masks. + * + * \param[in] Mode Mask of ADC prescale and mode settings. + */ + static inline void ADC_Init(const uint8_t Mode) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void ADC_Init(const uint8_t Mode) + { + ADCSRA = ((1 << ADEN) | Mode); + } + + /** Turns off the ADC. If this is called, any further ADC operations will require a call to + * \ref ADC_Init() before the ADC can be used again. + */ + static inline void ADC_Disable(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void ADC_Disable(void) + { + ADCSRA = 0; + } + + /** Indicates if the ADC is currently enabled. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the ADC subsystem is currently enabled, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool ADC_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool ADC_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((ADCSRA & (1 << ADEN)) ? true : false); + } + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/SPI_AVR8.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/SPI_AVR8.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7244f4a954 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/SPI_AVR8.h @@ -0,0 +1,258 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief SPI Peripheral Driver (AVR8) + * + * On-chip SPI driver for the 8-bit AVR microcontrollers. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the SPI driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SPI.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_SPI + * \defgroup Group_SPI_AVR8 SPI Peripheral Driver (AVR8) + * + * \section Sec_SPI_AVR8_ModDescription Module Description + * Driver for the hardware SPI port available on most 8-bit AVR microcontroller models. This + * module provides an easy to use driver for the setup and transfer of data over the + * AVR's SPI port. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the SPI driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SPI.h. + * + * \section Sec_SPI_AVR8_ExampleUsage Example Usage + * The following snippet is an example of how this module may be used within a typical + * application. + * + * \code + * // Initialize the SPI driver before first use + * SPI_Init(SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_2 | SPI_ORDER_MSB_FIRST | SPI_SCK_LEAD_FALLING | + * SPI_SAMPLE_TRAILING | SPI_MODE_MASTER); + * + * // Send several bytes, ignoring the returned data + * SPI_SendByte(0x01); + * SPI_SendByte(0x02); + * SPI_SendByte(0x03); + * + * // Receive several bytes, sending a dummy 0x00 byte each time + * uint8_t Byte1 = SPI_ReceiveByte(); + * uint8_t Byte2 = SPI_ReceiveByte(); + * uint8_t Byte3 = SPI_ReceiveByte(); + * + * // Send a byte, and store the received byte from the same transaction + * uint8_t ResponseByte = SPI_TransferByte(0xDC); + * \endcode + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __SPI_AVR8_H__ +#define __SPI_AVR8_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_SPI_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SPI.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define SPI_USE_DOUBLESPEED (1 << SPE) + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** \name SPI Prescaler Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** SPI prescaler mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Divides the system clock by a factor of 2. */ + #define SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_2 SPI_USE_DOUBLESPEED + + /** SPI prescaler mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Divides the system clock by a factor of 4. */ + #define SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_4 0 + + /** SPI prescaler mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Divides the system clock by a factor of 8. */ + #define SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_8 (SPI_USE_DOUBLESPEED | (1 << SPR0)) + + /** SPI prescaler mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Divides the system clock by a factor of 16. */ + #define SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_16 (1 << SPR0) + + /** SPI prescaler mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Divides the system clock by a factor of 32. */ + #define SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_32 (SPI_USE_DOUBLESPEED | (1 << SPR1)) + + /** SPI prescaler mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Divides the system clock by a factor of 64. */ + #define SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_64 (SPI_USE_DOUBLESPEED | (1 << SPR1) | (1 << SPR0)) + + /** SPI prescaler mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Divides the system clock by a factor of 128. */ + #define SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_128 ((1 << SPR1) | (1 << SPR0)) + //@} + + /** \name SPI SCK Polarity Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** SPI clock polarity mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Indicates that the SCK should lead on the rising edge. */ + #define SPI_SCK_LEAD_RISING (0 << CPOL) + + /** SPI clock polarity mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Indicates that the SCK should lead on the falling edge. */ + #define SPI_SCK_LEAD_FALLING (1 << CPOL) + //@} + + /** \name SPI Sample Edge Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** SPI data sample mode mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Indicates that the data should sampled on the leading edge. */ + #define SPI_SAMPLE_LEADING (0 << CPHA) + + /** SPI data sample mode mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Indicates that the data should be sampled on the trailing edge. */ + #define SPI_SAMPLE_TRAILING (1 << CPHA) + //@} + + /** \name SPI Data Ordering Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** SPI data order mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Indicates that data should be shifted out MSB first. */ + #define SPI_ORDER_MSB_FIRST (0 << DORD) + + /** SPI data order mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Indicates that data should be shifted out LSB first. */ + #define SPI_ORDER_LSB_FIRST (1 << DORD) + //@} + + /** \name SPI Mode Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** SPI mode mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Indicates that the SPI interface should be initialized into slave mode. */ + #define SPI_MODE_SLAVE (0 << MSTR) + + /** SPI mode mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Indicates that the SPI interface should be initialized into master mode. */ + #define SPI_MODE_MASTER (1 << MSTR) + //@} + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initializes the SPI subsystem, ready for transfers. Must be called before calling any other + * SPI routines. + * + * \param[in] SPIOptions SPI Options, a mask consisting of one of each of the \c SPI_SPEED_*, + * \c SPI_SCK_*, \c SPI_SAMPLE_*, \c SPI_ORDER_* and \c SPI_MODE_* masks. + */ + static inline void SPI_Init(const uint8_t SPIOptions); + static inline void SPI_Init(const uint8_t SPIOptions) + { + /* Prevent high rise times on PB.0 (/SS) from forcing a change to SPI slave mode */ + DDRB |= (1 << 0); + PORTB |= (1 << 0); + + DDRB |= ((1 << 1) | (1 << 2)); + DDRB &= ~(1 << 3); + PORTB |= (1 << 3); + + if (SPIOptions & SPI_USE_DOUBLESPEED) + SPSR |= (1 << SPI2X); + else + SPSR &= ~(1 << SPI2X); + + /* Switch /SS to input mode after configuration to allow for forced mode changes */ + DDRB &= ~(1 << 0); + + SPCR = ((1 << SPE) | SPIOptions); + } + + /** Turns off the SPI driver, disabling and returning used hardware to their default configuration. */ + static inline void SPI_Disable(void); + static inline void SPI_Disable(void) + { + DDRB &= ~((1 << 1) | (1 << 2)); + PORTB &= ~((1 << 0) | (1 << 3)); + + SPCR = 0; + SPSR = 0; + } + + /** Retrieves the currently selected SPI mode, once the SPI interface has been configured. + * + * \return \ref SPI_MODE_MASTER if the interface is currently in SPI Master mode, \ref SPI_MODE_SLAVE otherwise + */ + static inline uint8_t SPI_GetCurrentMode(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t SPI_GetCurrentMode(void) + { + return (SPCR & SPI_MODE_MASTER); + } + + /** Sends and receives a byte through the SPI interface, blocking until the transfer is complete. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte to send through the SPI interface. + * + * \return Response byte from the attached SPI device. + */ + static inline uint8_t SPI_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t SPI_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + SPDR = Byte; + while (!(SPSR & (1 << SPIF))); + return SPDR; + } + + /** Sends a byte through the SPI interface, blocking until the transfer is complete. The response + * byte sent to from the attached SPI device is ignored. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte to send through the SPI interface. + */ + static inline void SPI_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void SPI_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + SPDR = Byte; + while (!(SPSR & (1 << SPIF))); + } + + /** Sends a dummy byte through the SPI interface, blocking until the transfer is complete. The response + * byte from the attached SPI device is returned. + * + * \return The response byte from the attached SPI device. + */ + static inline uint8_t SPI_ReceiveByte(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t SPI_ReceiveByte(void) + { + SPDR = 0x00; + while (!(SPSR & (1 << SPIF))); + return SPDR; + } + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/SerialSPI_AVR8.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/SerialSPI_AVR8.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..052780e733 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/SerialSPI_AVR8.h @@ -0,0 +1,208 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Master SPI Mode Serial USART Peripheral Driver (XMEGA) + * + * On-chip Master SPI mode USART driver for the XMEGA AVR microcontrollers. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the SPI Master + * Mode USART driver dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_SerialSPI + * \defgroup Group_SerialSPI_AVR8 Master SPI Mode Serial USART Peripheral Driver (AVR8) + * + * \section Sec_SerialSPI_AVR8_ModDescription Module Description + * On-chip serial USART driver for the 8-bit AVR8 microcontrollers. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the SPI Master + * driver dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SerialSPI.h. + * + * \section Sec_SerialSPI_AVR8_ExampleUsage Example Usage + * The following snippet is an example of how this module may be used within a typical + * application. + * + * \code + * // Initialize the Master SPI mode USART driver before first use, with 1Mbit baud + * SerialSPI_Init((USART_SPI_SCK_LEAD_RISING | USART_SPI_SAMPLE_LEADING | USART_SPI_ORDER_MSB_FIRST), 1000000); + * + * // Send several bytes, ignoring the returned data + * SerialSPI_SendByte(0x01); + * SerialSPI_SendByte(0x02); + * SerialSPI_SendByte(0x03); + * + * // Receive several bytes, sending a dummy 0x00 byte each time + * uint8_t Byte1 = SerialSPI_ReceiveByte(); + * uint8_t Byte2 = SerialSPI_ReceiveByte(); + * uint8_t Byte3 = SerialSPI_ReceiveByte(); + * + * // Send a byte, and store the received byte from the same transaction + * uint8_t ResponseByte = SerialSPI_TransferByte(0xDC); + * \endcode + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __SERIAL_SPI_AVR8_H__ +#define __SERIAL_SPI_AVR8_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + + #include <stdio.h> + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_SERIAL_SPI_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #define SERIAL_SPI_UBBRVAL(Baud) ((Baud < (F_CPU / 2)) ? ((F_CPU / (2 * Baud)) - 1) : 0) + + /* Master USART SPI mode flag definitions missing in the AVR8 toolchain */ + #if !defined(UCPHA1) + #define UCPHA1 1 + #endif + #if !defined(UDORD1) + #define UDORD1 2 + #endif + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** \name SPI SCK Polarity Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** SPI clock polarity mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Indicates that the SCK should lead on the rising edge. */ + #define USART_SPI_SCK_LEAD_RISING (0 << UCPOL1) + + /** SPI clock polarity mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Indicates that the SCK should lead on the falling edge. */ + #define USART_SPI_SCK_LEAD_FALLING (1 << UCPOL1) + //@} + + /** \name SPI Sample Edge Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** SPI data sample mode mask for \ref SerialSPI_Init(). Indicates that the data should sampled on the leading edge. */ + #define USART_SPI_SAMPLE_LEADING (0 << UCPHA1) + + /** SPI data sample mode mask for \ref SerialSPI_Init(). Indicates that the data should be sampled on the trailing edge. */ + #define USART_SPI_SAMPLE_TRAILING (1 << UCPHA1) + //@} + + /** \name SPI Data Ordering Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** SPI data order mask for \ref SerialSPI_Init(). Indicates that data should be shifted out MSB first. */ + #define USART_SPI_ORDER_MSB_FIRST (0 << UDORD1) + + /** SPI data order mask for \ref SerialSPI_Init(). Indicates that data should be shifted out LSB first. */ + #define USART_SPI_ORDER_LSB_FIRST (1 << UDORD1) + //@} + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initialize the USART module in Master SPI mode. + * + * \param[in] SPIOptions USART SPI Options, a mask consisting of one of each of the \c USART_SPI_SCK_*, + * \c USART_SPI_SAMPLE_* and \c USART_SPI_ORDER_* masks. + * \param[in] BaudRate SPI baud rate, in bits per second. + */ + static inline void SerialSPI_Init(const uint8_t SPIOptions, + const uint32_t BaudRate) + { + DDRD |= ((1 << 3) | (1 << 5)); + PORTD |= (1 << 2); + + UCSR1C = ((1 << UMSEL11) | (1 << UMSEL10) | SPIOptions); + UCSR1B = ((1 << TXEN1) | (1 << RXEN1)); + + UBRR1 = SERIAL_SPI_UBBRVAL(BaudRate); + } + + /** Turns off the USART driver, disabling and returning used hardware to their default configuration. */ + static inline void SerialSPI_Disable(void) + { + UCSR1B = 0; + UCSR1A = 0; + UCSR1C = 0; + + UBRR1 = 0; + + DDRD &= ~((1 << 3) | (1 << 5)); + PORTD &= ~(1 << 2); + } + + /** Sends and receives a byte through the USART SPI interface, blocking until the transfer is complete. + * + * \param[in] DataByte Byte to send through the USART SPI interface. + * + * \return Response byte from the attached SPI device. + */ + static inline uint8_t SerialSPI_TransferByte(const uint8_t DataByte) + { + UDR1 = DataByte; + while (!(UCSR1A & (1 << TXC1))); + UCSR1A = (1 << TXC1); + return UDR1; + } + + /** Sends a byte through the USART SPI interface, blocking until the transfer is complete. The response + * byte sent to from the attached SPI device is ignored. + * + * \param[in] DataByte Byte to send through the USART SPI interface. + */ + static inline void SerialSPI_SendByte(const uint8_t DataByte) + { + SerialSPI_TransferByte(DataByte); + } + + /** Sends a dummy byte through the USART SPI interface, blocking until the transfer is complete. The response + * byte from the attached SPI device is returned. + * + * \return The response byte from the attached SPI device. + */ + static inline uint8_t SerialSPI_ReceiveByte(void) + { + return SerialSPI_TransferByte(0); + } + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/Serial_AVR8.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/Serial_AVR8.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..779a80c48c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/Serial_AVR8.c @@ -0,0 +1,121 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_SERIAL_C +#include "../Serial.h" + +FILE USARTSerialStream; + +int Serial_putchar(char DataByte, + FILE *Stream) +{ + (void)Stream; + + Serial_SendByte(DataByte); + return 0; +} + +int Serial_getchar(FILE *Stream) +{ + (void)Stream; + + if (!(Serial_IsCharReceived())) + return _FDEV_EOF; + + return Serial_ReceiveByte(); +} + +int Serial_getchar_Blocking(FILE *Stream) +{ + (void)Stream; + + while (!(Serial_IsCharReceived())); + return Serial_ReceiveByte(); +} + +void Serial_SendString_P(const char* FlashStringPtr) +{ + uint8_t CurrByte; + + while ((CurrByte = pgm_read_byte(FlashStringPtr)) != 0x00) + { + Serial_SendByte(CurrByte); + FlashStringPtr++; + } +} + +void Serial_SendString(const char* StringPtr) +{ + uint8_t CurrByte; + + while ((CurrByte = *StringPtr) != 0x00) + { + Serial_SendByte(CurrByte); + StringPtr++; + } +} + +void Serial_SendData(const void* Buffer, + uint16_t Length) +{ + uint8_t* CurrByte = (uint8_t*)Buffer; + + while (Length--) + Serial_SendByte(*(CurrByte++)); +} + +void Serial_CreateStream(FILE* Stream) +{ + if (!(Stream)) + { + Stream = &USARTSerialStream; + stdin = Stream; + stdout = Stream; + } + + *Stream = (FILE)FDEV_SETUP_STREAM(Serial_putchar, Serial_getchar, _FDEV_SETUP_RW); +} + +void Serial_CreateBlockingStream(FILE* Stream) +{ + if (!(Stream)) + { + Stream = &USARTSerialStream; + stdin = Stream; + stdout = Stream; + } + + *Stream = (FILE)FDEV_SETUP_STREAM(Serial_putchar, Serial_getchar_Blocking, _FDEV_SETUP_RW); +} + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/Serial_AVR8.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/Serial_AVR8.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b3e7ee36a4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/Serial_AVR8.h @@ -0,0 +1,271 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Serial USART Peripheral Driver (AVR8) + * + * On-chip serial USART driver for the 8-bit AVR microcontrollers. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USART driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Serial + * \defgroup Group_Serial_AVR8 Serial USART Peripheral Driver (AVR8) + * + * \section Sec_Serial_AVR8_ModDescription Module Description + * On-chip serial USART driver for the 8-bit AVR microcontrollers. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USART driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h. + * + * \section Sec_Serial_AVR8_ExampleUsage Example Usage + * The following snippet is an example of how this module may be used within a typical + * application. + * + * \code + * // Initialize the serial USART driver before first use, with 9600 baud (and no double-speed mode) + * Serial_Init(9600, false); + * + * // Send a string through the USART + * Serial_SendString("Test String\r\n"); + * + * // Send a raw byte through the USART + * Serial_SendByte(0xDC); + * + * // Receive a byte through the USART (or -1 if no data received) + * int16_t DataByte = Serial_ReceiveByte(); + * \endcode + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __SERIAL_AVR8_H__ +#define __SERIAL_AVR8_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Misc/TerminalCodes.h" + + #include <stdio.h> + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_SERIAL_H) && !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_SERIAL_C) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* External Variables: */ + extern FILE USARTSerialStream; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + int Serial_putchar(char DataByte, + FILE *Stream); + int Serial_getchar(FILE *Stream); + int Serial_getchar_Blocking(FILE *Stream); + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Macro for calculating the baud value from a given baud rate when the \c U2X (double speed) bit is + * not set. + * + * \param[in] Baud Target serial UART baud rate. + * + * \return Closest UBRR register value for the given UART frequency. + */ + #define SERIAL_UBBRVAL(Baud) ((((F_CPU / 16) + (Baud / 2)) / (Baud)) - 1) + + /** Macro for calculating the baud value from a given baud rate when the \c U2X (double speed) bit is + * set. + * + * \param[in] Baud Target serial UART baud rate. + * + * \return Closest UBRR register value for the given UART frequency. + */ + #define SERIAL_2X_UBBRVAL(Baud) ((((F_CPU / 8) + (Baud / 2)) / (Baud)) - 1) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Transmits a given NUL terminated string located in program space (FLASH) through the USART. + * + * \param[in] FlashStringPtr Pointer to a string located in program space. + */ + void Serial_SendString_P(const char* FlashStringPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Transmits a given NUL terminated string located in SRAM memory through the USART. + * + * \param[in] StringPtr Pointer to a string located in SRAM space. + */ + void Serial_SendString(const char* StringPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Transmits a given buffer located in SRAM memory through the USART. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to a buffer containing the data to send. + * \param[in] Length Length of the data to send, in bytes. + */ + void Serial_SendData(const void* Buffer, uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Creates a standard character stream from the USART so that it can be used with all the regular functions + * in the avr-libc \c <stdio.h> library that accept a \c FILE stream as a destination (e.g. \c fprintf). The created + * stream is bidirectional and can be used for both input and output functions. + * + * Reading data from this stream is non-blocking, i.e. in most instances, complete strings cannot be read in by a single + * fetch, as the endpoint will not be ready at some point in the transmission, aborting the transfer. However, this may + * be used when the read data is processed byte-per-bye (via \c getc()) or when the user application will implement its own + * line buffering. + * + * \param[in,out] Stream Pointer to a FILE structure where the created stream should be placed, if \c NULL, \c stdout + * and \c stdin will be configured to use the USART. + * + * \pre The USART must first be configured via a call to \ref Serial_Init() before the stream is used. + */ + void Serial_CreateStream(FILE* Stream); + + /** Identical to \ref Serial_CreateStream(), except that reads are blocking until the calling stream function terminates + * the transfer. + * + * \param[in,out] Stream Pointer to a FILE structure where the created stream should be placed, if \c NULL, \c stdout + * and \c stdin will be configured to use the USART. + * + * \pre The USART must first be configured via a call to \ref Serial_Init() before the stream is used. + */ + void Serial_CreateBlockingStream(FILE* Stream); + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initializes the USART, ready for serial data transmission and reception. This initializes the interface to + * standard 8-bit, no parity, 1 stop bit settings suitable for most applications. + * + * \param[in] BaudRate Serial baud rate, in bits per second. This should be the target baud rate regardless of the + * \c DoubleSpeed parameter's value. + * \param[in] DoubleSpeed Enables double speed mode when set, halving the sample time to double the baud rate. + */ + static inline void Serial_Init(const uint32_t BaudRate, + const bool DoubleSpeed); + static inline void Serial_Init(const uint32_t BaudRate, + const bool DoubleSpeed) + { + UBRR1 = (DoubleSpeed ? SERIAL_2X_UBBRVAL(BaudRate) : SERIAL_UBBRVAL(BaudRate)); + + UCSR1C = ((1 << UCSZ11) | (1 << UCSZ10)); + UCSR1A = (DoubleSpeed ? (1 << U2X1) : 0); + UCSR1B = ((1 << TXEN1) | (1 << RXEN1)); + + DDRD |= (1 << 3); + PORTD |= (1 << 2); + } + + /** Turns off the USART driver, disabling and returning used hardware to their default configuration. */ + static inline void Serial_Disable(void); + static inline void Serial_Disable(void) + { + UCSR1B = 0; + UCSR1A = 0; + UCSR1C = 0; + + UBRR1 = 0; + + DDRD &= ~(1 << 3); + PORTD &= ~(1 << 2); + } + + /** Indicates whether a character has been received through the USART. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if a character has been received, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Serial_IsCharReceived(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Serial_IsCharReceived(void) + { + return ((UCSR1A & (1 << RXC1)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Indicates whether there is hardware buffer space for a new transmit on the USART. This + * function can be used to determine if a call to \ref Serial_SendByte() will block in advance. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if a character can be queued for transmission immediately, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Serial_IsSendReady(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Serial_IsSendReady(void) + { + return ((UCSR1A & (1 << UDRE1)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Indicates whether the hardware USART transmit buffer is completely empty, indicating all + * pending transmissions have completed. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if no characters are buffered for transmission, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Serial_IsSendComplete(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Serial_IsSendComplete(void) + { + return ((UCSR1A & (1 << TXC1)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Transmits a given byte through the USART. + * + * \note If no buffer space is available in the hardware USART, this function will block. To check if + * space is available before calling this function, see \ref Serial_IsSendReady(). + * + * \param[in] DataByte Byte to transmit through the USART. + */ + static inline void Serial_SendByte(const char DataByte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Serial_SendByte(const char DataByte) + { + while (!(Serial_IsSendReady())); + UDR1 = DataByte; + } + + /** Receives the next byte from the USART. + * + * \return Next byte received from the USART, or a negative value if no byte has been received. + */ + static inline int16_t Serial_ReceiveByte(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline int16_t Serial_ReceiveByte(void) + { + if (!(Serial_IsCharReceived())) + return -1; + + return UDR1; + } + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/TWI_AVR8.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/TWI_AVR8.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..eb08687be3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/TWI_AVR8.c @@ -0,0 +1,209 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) && defined(TWCR) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_TWI_C +#include "../TWI.h" + +uint8_t TWI_StartTransmission(const uint8_t SlaveAddress, + const uint8_t TimeoutMS) +{ + for (;;) + { + bool BusCaptured = false; + uint16_t TimeoutRemaining; + + TWCR = ((1 << TWINT) | (1 << TWSTA) | (1 << TWEN)); + + TimeoutRemaining = (TimeoutMS * 100); + while (TimeoutRemaining && !(BusCaptured)) + { + if (TWCR & (1 << TWINT)) + { + switch (TWSR & TW_STATUS_MASK) + { + case TW_START: + case TW_REP_START: + BusCaptured = true; + break; + case TW_MT_ARB_LOST: + TWCR = ((1 << TWINT) | (1 << TWSTA) | (1 << TWEN)); + continue; + default: + TWCR = (1 << TWEN); + return TWI_ERROR_BusFault; + } + } + + _delay_us(10); + TimeoutRemaining--; + } + + if (!(TimeoutRemaining)) + { + TWCR = (1 << TWEN); + return TWI_ERROR_BusCaptureTimeout; + } + + TWDR = SlaveAddress; + TWCR = ((1 << TWINT) | (1 << TWEN)); + + TimeoutRemaining = (TimeoutMS * 100); + while (TimeoutRemaining) + { + if (TWCR & (1 << TWINT)) + break; + + _delay_us(10); + TimeoutRemaining--; + } + + if (!(TimeoutRemaining)) + return TWI_ERROR_SlaveResponseTimeout; + + switch (TWSR & TW_STATUS_MASK) + { + case TW_MT_SLA_ACK: + case TW_MR_SLA_ACK: + return TWI_ERROR_NoError; + default: + TWCR = ((1 << TWINT) | (1 << TWSTO) | (1 << TWEN)); + return TWI_ERROR_SlaveNotReady; + } + } +} + +bool TWI_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) +{ + TWDR = Byte; + TWCR = ((1 << TWINT) | (1 << TWEN)); + while (!(TWCR & (1 << TWINT))); + + return ((TWSR & TW_STATUS_MASK) == TW_MT_DATA_ACK); +} + +bool TWI_ReceiveByte(uint8_t* const Byte, + const bool LastByte) +{ + uint8_t TWCRMask; + + if (LastByte) + TWCRMask = ((1 << TWINT) | (1 << TWEN)); + else + TWCRMask = ((1 << TWINT) | (1 << TWEN) | (1 << TWEA)); + + TWCR = TWCRMask; + while (!(TWCR & (1 << TWINT))); + *Byte = TWDR; + + uint8_t Status = (TWSR & TW_STATUS_MASK); + + return ((LastByte) ? (Status == TW_MR_DATA_NACK) : (Status == TW_MR_DATA_ACK)); +} + +uint8_t TWI_ReadPacket(const uint8_t SlaveAddress, + const uint8_t TimeoutMS, + const uint8_t* InternalAddress, + uint8_t InternalAddressLen, + uint8_t* Buffer, + uint16_t Length) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((ErrorCode = TWI_StartTransmission((SlaveAddress & TWI_DEVICE_ADDRESS_MASK) | TWI_ADDRESS_WRITE, + TimeoutMS)) == TWI_ERROR_NoError) + { + while (InternalAddressLen--) + { + if (!(TWI_SendByte(*(InternalAddress++)))) + { + ErrorCode = TWI_ERROR_SlaveNAK; + break; + } + } + + if ((ErrorCode = TWI_StartTransmission((SlaveAddress & TWI_DEVICE_ADDRESS_MASK) | TWI_ADDRESS_READ, + TimeoutMS)) == TWI_ERROR_NoError) + { + while (Length--) + { + if (!(TWI_ReceiveByte(Buffer++, (Length == 0)))) + { + ErrorCode = TWI_ERROR_SlaveNAK; + break; + } + } + + TWI_StopTransmission(); + } + } + + return ErrorCode; +} + +uint8_t TWI_WritePacket(const uint8_t SlaveAddress, + const uint8_t TimeoutMS, + const uint8_t* InternalAddress, + uint8_t InternalAddressLen, + const uint8_t* Buffer, + uint16_t Length) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((ErrorCode = TWI_StartTransmission((SlaveAddress & TWI_DEVICE_ADDRESS_MASK) | TWI_ADDRESS_WRITE, + TimeoutMS)) == TWI_ERROR_NoError) + { + while (InternalAddressLen--) + { + if (!(TWI_SendByte(*(InternalAddress++)))) + { + ErrorCode = TWI_ERROR_SlaveNAK; + break; + } + } + + while (Length--) + { + if (!(TWI_SendByte(*(Buffer++)))) + { + ErrorCode = TWI_ERROR_SlaveNAK; + break; + } + } + + TWI_StopTransmission(); + } + + return ErrorCode; +} + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/TWI_AVR8.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/TWI_AVR8.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a8b845a5d7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/TWI_AVR8.h @@ -0,0 +1,305 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief TWI Peripheral Driver (AVR8) + * + * On-chip TWI driver for the 8-bit AVR microcontrollers. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the TWI driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/TWI.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_TWI + * \defgroup Group_TWI_AVR8 TWI Peripheral Driver (AVR8) + * + * \section Sec_TWI_AVR8_ModDescription Module Description + * Master mode TWI driver for the 8-bit AVR microcontrollers which contain a hardware TWI module. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the TWI driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/TWI.h. + * + * \section Sec_TWI_AVR8_ExampleUsage Example Usage + * The following snippet is an example of how this module may be used within a typical + * application. + * + * <b>Low Level API Example:</b> + * \code + * // Initialize the TWI driver before first use at 200KHz + * TWI_Init(TWI_BIT_PRESCALE_1, TWI_BITLENGTH_FROM_FREQ(1, 200000)); + * + * // Start a write session to device at device address 0xA0, internal address 0xDC with a 10ms timeout + * if (TWI_StartTransmission(0xA0 | TWI_ADDRESS_WRITE, 10) == TWI_ERROR_NoError) + * { + * TWI_SendByte(0xDC); + * + * TWI_SendByte(0x01); + * TWI_SendByte(0x02); + * TWI_SendByte(0x03); + * + * // Must stop transmission afterwards to release the bus + * TWI_StopTransmission(); + * } + * + * // Start a read session to device at address 0xA0, internal address 0xDC with a 10ms timeout + * if (TWI_StartTransmission(0xA0 | TWI_ADDRESS_WRITE, 10) == TWI_ERROR_NoError) + * { + * TWI_SendByte(0xDC); + * TWI_StopTransmission(); + * + * if (TWI_StartTransmission(0xA0 | TWI_ADDRESS_READ, 10) == TWI_ERROR_NoError) + * { + * uint8_t Byte1, Byte2, Byte3; + * + * // Read three bytes, acknowledge after the third byte is received + * TWI_ReceiveByte(&Byte1, false); + * TWI_ReceiveByte(&Byte2, false); + * TWI_ReceiveByte(&Byte3, true); + * + * // Must stop transmission afterwards to release the bus + * TWI_StopTransmission(); + * } + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>High Level API Example:</b> + * \code + * // Initialize the TWI driver before first use at 200KHz + * TWI_Init(TWI_BIT_PRESCALE_1, TWI_BITLENGTH_FROM_FREQ(1, 200000)); + * + * // Start a write session to device at device address 0xA0, internal address 0xDC with a 10ms timeout + * uint8_t InternalWriteAddress = 0xDC; + * uint8_t WritePacket[3] = {0x01, 0x02, 0x03}; + * + * TWI_WritePacket(0xA0, 10, &InternalWriteAddress, sizeof(InternalWriteAddress), + * &WritePacket, sizeof(WritePacket); + * + * // Start a read session to device at address 0xA0, internal address 0xDC with a 10ms timeout + * uint8_t InternalReadAddress = 0xDC; + * uint8_t ReadPacket[3]; + * + * TWI_ReadPacket(0xA0, 10, &InternalReadAddress, sizeof(InternalReadAddress), + * &ReadPacket, sizeof(ReadPacket); + * \endcode + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __TWI_AVR8_H__ +#define __TWI_AVR8_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + + #include <stdio.h> + #include <util/twi.h> + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_TWI_H) && !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_TWI_C) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/TWI.h instead. + #endif + + #if !(defined(__AVR_AT90USB1286__) || defined(__AVR_AT90USB646__) || \ + defined(__AVR_AT90USB1287__) || defined(__AVR_AT90USB647__) || \ + defined(__AVR_ATmega16U4__) || defined(__AVR_ATmega32U4__)) + #error The TWI peripheral driver is not currently available for your selected microcontroller model. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** TWI slave device address mask for a read session. Mask with a slave device base address to obtain + * the correct TWI bus address for the slave device when reading data from it. + */ + #define TWI_ADDRESS_READ 0x01 + + /** TWI slave device address mask for a write session. Mask with a slave device base address to obtain + * the correct TWI bus address for the slave device when writing data to it. + */ + #define TWI_ADDRESS_WRITE 0x00 + + /** Mask to retrieve the base address for a TWI device, which can then be ORed with \ref TWI_ADDRESS_READ + * or \ref TWI_ADDRESS_WRITE to obtain the device's read and write address respectively. + */ + #define TWI_DEVICE_ADDRESS_MASK 0xFE + + /** Bit length prescaler for \ref TWI_Init(). This mask multiplies the TWI bit length prescaler by 1. */ + #define TWI_BIT_PRESCALE_1 ((0 << TWPS1) | (0 << TWPS0)) + + /** Bit length prescaler for \ref TWI_Init(). This mask multiplies the TWI bit length prescaler by 4. */ + #define TWI_BIT_PRESCALE_4 ((0 << TWPS1) | (1 << TWPS0)) + + /** Bit length prescaler for \ref TWI_Init(). This mask multiplies the TWI bit length prescaler by 16. */ + #define TWI_BIT_PRESCALE_16 ((1 << TWPS1) | (0 << TWPS0)) + + /** Bit length prescaler for \ref TWI_Init(). This mask multiplies the TWI bit length prescaler by 64. */ + #define TWI_BIT_PRESCALE_64 ((1 << TWPS1) | (1 << TWPS0)) + + /** Calculates the length of each bit on the TWI bus for a given target frequency. This may be used with + * the \ref TWI_Init() function to convert a bus frequency to a number of clocks for the \c BitLength + * parameter. + * + * \param[in] Prescale Prescaler set on the TWI bus. + * \param[in] Frequency Desired TWI bus frequency in Hz. + * + * \return Bit length in clocks for the given TWI bus frequency at the given prescaler value. + */ + #define TWI_BITLENGTH_FROM_FREQ(Prescale, Frequency) ((((F_CPU / (Prescale)) / (Frequency)) - 16) / 2) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the TWI transfer start routine and other dependant TWI functions. */ + enum TWI_ErrorCodes_t + { + TWI_ERROR_NoError = 0, /**< Indicates that the command completed successfully. */ + TWI_ERROR_BusFault = 1, /**< A TWI bus fault occurred while attempting to capture the bus. */ + TWI_ERROR_BusCaptureTimeout = 2, /**< A timeout occurred whilst waiting for the bus to be ready. */ + TWI_ERROR_SlaveResponseTimeout = 3, /**< No ACK received at the nominated slave address within the timeout period. */ + TWI_ERROR_SlaveNotReady = 4, /**< Slave NAKed the TWI bus START condition. */ + TWI_ERROR_SlaveNAK = 5, /**< Slave NAKed whilst attempting to send data to the device. */ + }; + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initializes the TWI hardware into master mode, ready for data transmission and reception. This must be + * before any other TWI operations. + * + * The generated SCL frequency will be according to the formula <pre>F_CPU / (16 + 2 * BitLength + 4 ^ Prescale)</pre>. + * + * \attention The value of the \c BitLength parameter should not be set below 10 or invalid bus conditions may + * occur, as indicated in the AVR8 microcontroller datasheet. + * + * \param[in] Prescale Prescaler to use when determining the bus frequency, a \c TWI_BIT_PRESCALE_* value. + * \param[in] BitLength Length of the bits sent on the bus. + */ + static inline void TWI_Init(const uint8_t Prescale, + const uint8_t BitLength) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void TWI_Init(const uint8_t Prescale, + const uint8_t BitLength) + { + TWCR |= (1 << TWEN); + TWSR = Prescale; + TWBR = BitLength; + } + + /** Turns off the TWI driver hardware. If this is called, any further TWI operations will require a call to + * \ref TWI_Init() before the TWI can be used again. + */ + static inline void TWI_Disable(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void TWI_Disable(void) + { + TWCR &= ~(1 << TWEN); + } + + /** Sends a TWI STOP onto the TWI bus, terminating communication with the currently addressed device. */ + static inline void TWI_StopTransmission(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void TWI_StopTransmission(void) + { + TWCR = ((1 << TWINT) | (1 << TWSTO) | (1 << TWEN)); + } + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Begins a master mode TWI bus communication with the given slave device address. + * + * \param[in] SlaveAddress Address of the slave TWI device to communicate with. + * \param[in] TimeoutMS Timeout period within which the slave must respond, in milliseconds. + * + * \return A value from the \ref TWI_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t TWI_StartTransmission(const uint8_t SlaveAddress, + const uint8_t TimeoutMS); + + /** Sends a byte to the currently addressed device on the TWI bus. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte to send to the currently addressed device + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the recipient ACKed the byte, \c false otherwise + */ + bool TWI_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte); + + /** Receives a byte from the currently addressed device on the TWI bus. + * + * \param[in] Byte Location where the read byte is to be stored. + * \param[in] LastByte Indicates if the byte should be ACKed if false, NAKed if true. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the byte reception successfully completed, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool TWI_ReceiveByte(uint8_t* const Byte, + const bool LastByte) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** High level function to perform a complete packet transfer over the TWI bus to the specified + * device. + * + * \param[in] SlaveAddress Base address of the TWI slave device to communicate with. + * \param[in] TimeoutMS Timeout for bus capture and slave START ACK, in milliseconds. + * \param[in] InternalAddress Pointer to a location where the internal slave read start address is stored. + * \param[in] InternalAddressLen Size of the internal device address, in bytes. + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to a buffer where the read packet data is to be stored. + * \param[in] Length Size of the packet to read, in bytes. + * + * \return A value from the \ref TWI_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t TWI_ReadPacket(const uint8_t SlaveAddress, + const uint8_t TimeoutMS, + const uint8_t* InternalAddress, + uint8_t InternalAddressLen, + uint8_t* Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /** High level function to perform a complete packet transfer over the TWI bus from the specified + * device. + * + * \param[in] SlaveAddress Base address of the TWI slave device to communicate with + * \param[in] TimeoutMS Timeout for bus capture and slave START ACK, in milliseconds + * \param[in] InternalAddress Pointer to a location where the internal slave write start address is stored + * \param[in] InternalAddressLen Size of the internal device address, in bytes + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to a buffer where the packet data to send is stored + * \param[in] Length Size of the packet to send, in bytes + * + * \return A value from the \ref TWI_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t TWI_WritePacket(const uint8_t SlaveAddress, + const uint8_t TimeoutMS, + const uint8_t* InternalAddress, + uint8_t InternalAddressLen, + const uint8_t* Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SPI.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SPI.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f0cd177e00 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SPI.h @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Hardware Serial Peripheral Interface driver. + * + * This file is the master dispatch header file for the device-specific SPI driver, for microcontrollers + * containing a hardware SPI. + * + * User code should include this file, which will in turn include the correct SPI driver header file for the + * currently selected architecture and microcontroller model. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PeripheralDrivers + * \defgroup Group_SPI SPI Driver - LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SPI.h + * \brief Hardware Serial Peripheral Interface driver. + * + * \section Sec_SPI_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - None + * + * \section Sec_SPI_ModDescription Module Description + * Hardware SPI driver. This module provides an easy to use driver for the setup and transfer of data over + * the selected architecture and microcontroller model's SPI port. + * + * \note The exact API for this driver may vary depending on the target used - see + * individual target module documentation for the API specific to your target processor. + */ + +#ifndef __SPI_H__ +#define __SPI_H__ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_SPI_H + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Includes: */ + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + #include "AVR8/SPI_AVR8.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + #include "XMEGA/SPI_XMEGA.h" + #else + #error The SPI peripheral driver is not currently available for your selected architecture. + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0c537bcd34 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Hardware Serial USART driver. + * + * This file is the master dispatch header file for the device-specific USART driver, for microcontrollers + * containing a hardware USART. + * + * User code should include this file, which will in turn include the correct ADC driver header file for the + * currently selected architecture and microcontroller model. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PeripheralDrivers + * \defgroup Group_Serial Serial USART Driver - LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h + * \brief Hardware Serial USART driver. + * + * \section Sec_Serial_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/<i>ARCH</i>/Serial_<i>ARCH</i>.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_SERIAL)</i> + * + * \section Sec_Serial_ModDescription Module Description + * Hardware serial USART driver. This module provides an easy to use driver for the setup and transfer + * of data over the selected architecture and microcontroller model's USART port. + * + * \note The exact API for this driver may vary depending on the target used - see + * individual target module documentation for the API specific to your target processor. + */ + +#ifndef __SERIAL_H__ +#define __SERIAL_H__ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_SERIAL_H + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Includes: */ + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + #include "AVR8/Serial_AVR8.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + #include "XMEGA/Serial_XMEGA.h" + #else + #error The Serial peripheral driver is not currently available for your selected architecture. + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SerialSPI.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SerialSPI.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dbab9dbf03 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SerialSPI.h @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Hardware SPI Master Mode Serial USART driver. + * + * This file is the master dispatch header file for the device-specific SPI Master Mode USART driver, for + * microcontrollers containing a hardware USART capable of operating in a Master SPI mode. + * + * User code should include this file, which will in turn include the correct ADC driver header file for the + * currently selected architecture and microcontroller model. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PeripheralDrivers + * \defgroup Group_SerialSPI Master SPI Mode Serial USART Driver - LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SerialSPI.h + * \brief Hardware SPI Master Mode Serial USART driver. + * + * \section Sec_SerialSPI_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - None + * + * \section Sec_SerialSPI_ModDescription Module Description + * Hardware SPI Master Mode serial USART driver. This module provides an easy to use driver for the setup and transfer + * of data over the selected architecture and microcontroller model's USART port, using a SPI framing format. + * + * \note The exact API for this driver may vary depending on the target used - see + * individual target module documentation for the API specific to your target processor. + */ + +#ifndef __SERIAL_SPI_H__ +#define __SERIAL_SPI_H__ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_SERIAL_SPI_H + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Includes: */ + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + #include "AVR8/SerialSPI_AVR8.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + #include "XMEGA/SerialSPI_XMEGA.h" + #else + #error The Serial SPI Master Mode peripheral driver is not currently available for your selected architecture. + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/TWI.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/TWI.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..24483d8e13 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/TWI.h @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Hardware Two Wire Interface (I2C) driver. + * + * This file is the master dispatch header file for the device-specific SPI driver, for microcontrollers + * containing a hardware TWI. + * + * User code should include this file, which will in turn include the correct TWI driver header file for the + * currently selected architecture and microcontroller model. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PeripheralDrivers + * \defgroup Group_TWI TWI Driver - LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/TWI.h + * \brief Hardware Two Wire Interface (I2C) driver. + * + * \section Sec_TWI_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/<i>ARCH</i>/TWI_<i>ARCH</i>.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_TWI)</i> + * + * \section Sec_TWI_ModDescription Module Description + * Hardware TWI driver. This module provides an easy to use driver for the setup and transfer of data over + * the selected architecture and microcontroller model's TWI bus port. + * + * \note The exact API for this driver may vary depending on the target used - see + * individual target module documentation for the API specific to your target processor. + */ + +#ifndef __TWI_H__ +#define __TWI_H__ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_TWI_H + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Includes: */ + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + #include "AVR8/TWI_AVR8.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + #include "XMEGA/TWI_XMEGA.h" + #else + #error The TWI peripheral driver is not currently available for your selected architecture. + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/SPI_XMEGA.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/SPI_XMEGA.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7797df11a9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/SPI_XMEGA.h @@ -0,0 +1,251 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief SPI Peripheral Driver (XMEGA) + * + * On-chip SPI driver for the XMEGA microcontrollers. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the SPI driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SPI.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_SPI + * \defgroup Group_SPI_XMEGA SPI Peripheral Driver (XMEGA) + * + * \section Sec_SPI_XMEGA_ModDescription Module Description + * Driver for the hardware SPI port(s) available on XMEGA AVR microcontroller models. This + * module provides an easy to use driver for the setup and transfer of data over the AVR's + * SPI ports. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the SPI driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SPI.h. + * + * \code + * // Initialize the SPI driver before first use + * SPI_Init(&SPIC, + * SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_2 | SPI_ORDER_MSB_FIRST | SPI_SCK_LEAD_FALLING | + * SPI_SAMPLE_TRAILING | SPI_MODE_MASTER); + * + * // Send several bytes, ignoring the returned data + * SPI_SendByte(&SPIC, 0x01); + * SPI_SendByte(&SPIC, 0x02); + * SPI_SendByte(&SPIC, 0x03); + * + * // Receive several bytes, sending a dummy 0x00 byte each time + * uint8_t Byte1 = SPI_ReceiveByte(&SPIC); + * uint8_t Byte2 = SPI_ReceiveByte(&SPIC); + * uint8_t Byte3 = SPI_ReceiveByte(&SPIC); + * + * // Send a byte, and store the received byte from the same transaction + * uint8_t ResponseByte = SPI_TransferByte(&SPIC, 0xDC); + * \endcode + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __SPI_XMEGA_H__ +#define __SPI_XMEGA_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_SPI_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SPI.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define SPI_USE_DOUBLESPEED SPI_CLK2X_bm + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** \name SPI Prescaler Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** SPI prescaler mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Divides the system clock by a factor of 2. */ + #define SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_2 SPI_USE_DOUBLESPEED + + /** SPI prescaler mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Divides the system clock by a factor of 4. */ + #define SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_4 0 + + /** SPI prescaler mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Divides the system clock by a factor of 8. */ + #define SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_8 (SPI_USE_DOUBLESPEED | (1 << SPI_PRESCALER_gp)) + + /** SPI prescaler mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Divides the system clock by a factor of 16. */ + #define SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_16 (1 << SPI_PRESCALER_gp) + + /** SPI prescaler mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Divides the system clock by a factor of 32. */ + #define SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_32 (SPI_USE_DOUBLESPEED | (2 << SPI_PRESCALER_gp)) + + /** SPI prescaler mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Divides the system clock by a factor of 64. */ + #define SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_64 (2 << SPI_PRESCALER_gp) + + /** SPI prescaler mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Divides the system clock by a factor of 128. */ + #define SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_128 (3 << SPI_PRESCALER_gp) + //@} + + /** \name SPI SCK Polarity Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** SPI clock polarity mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Indicates that the SCK should lead on the rising edge. */ + #define SPI_SCK_LEAD_RISING 0 + + /** SPI clock polarity mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Indicates that the SCK should lead on the falling edge. */ + #define SPI_SCK_LEAD_FALLING SPI_MODE1_bm + //@} + + /** \name SPI Sample Edge Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** SPI data sample mode mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Indicates that the data should sampled on the leading edge. */ + #define SPI_SAMPLE_LEADING 0 + + /** SPI data sample mode mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Indicates that the data should be sampled on the trailing edge. */ + #define SPI_SAMPLE_TRAILING SPI_MODE0_bm + //@} + + /** \name SPI Data Ordering Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** SPI data order mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Indicates that data should be shifted out MSB first. */ + #define SPI_ORDER_MSB_FIRST 0 + + /** SPI data order mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Indicates that data should be shifted out LSB first. */ + #define SPI_ORDER_LSB_FIRST SPI_DORD_bm + //@} + + /** \name SPI Mode Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** SPI mode mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Indicates that the SPI interface should be initialized into slave mode. */ + #define SPI_MODE_SLAVE 0 + + /** SPI mode mask for \ref SPI_Init(). Indicates that the SPI interface should be initialized into master mode. */ + #define SPI_MODE_MASTER SPI_MASTER_bm + //@} + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initializes the SPI subsystem, ready for transfers. Must be called before calling any other + * SPI routines. + * + * \param[in,out] SPI Pointer to the base of the SPI peripheral within the device. + * \param[in] SPIOptions SPI Options, a mask consisting of one of each of the \c SPI_SPEED_*, + * \c SPI_SCK_*, \c SPI_SAMPLE_*, \c SPI_ORDER_* and \c SPI_MODE_* masks. + */ + static inline void SPI_Init(SPI_t* const SPI, + const uint8_t SPIOptions) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void SPI_Init(SPI_t* const SPI, + const uint8_t SPIOptions) + { + SPI->CTRL = (SPIOptions | SPI_ENABLE_bm); + } + + /** Turns off the SPI driver, disabling and returning used hardware to their default configuration. + * + * \param[in,out] SPI Pointer to the base of the SPI peripheral within the device. + */ + static inline void SPI_Disable(SPI_t* const SPI) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void SPI_Disable(SPI_t* const SPI) + { + SPI->CTRL &= ~SPI_ENABLE_bm; + } + + /** Retrieves the currently selected SPI mode, once the SPI interface has been configured. + * + * \param[in,out] SPI Pointer to the base of the SPI peripheral within the device. + * + * \return \ref SPI_MODE_MASTER if the interface is currently in SPI Master mode, \ref SPI_MODE_SLAVE otherwise + */ + static inline uint8_t SPI_GetCurrentMode(SPI_t* const SPI) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline uint8_t SPI_GetCurrentMode(SPI_t* const SPI) + { + return (SPI->CTRL & SPI_MASTER_bm); + } + + /** Sends and receives a byte through the SPI interface, blocking until the transfer is complete. + * + * \param[in,out] SPI Pointer to the base of the SPI peripheral within the device. + * \param[in] Byte Byte to send through the SPI interface. + * + * \return Response byte from the attached SPI device. + */ + static inline uint8_t SPI_TransferByte(SPI_t* const SPI, + const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline uint8_t SPI_TransferByte(SPI_t* const SPI, + const uint8_t Byte) + { + SPI->DATA = Byte; + while (!(SPI->STATUS & SPI_IF_bm)); + return SPI->DATA; + } + + /** Sends a byte through the SPI interface, blocking until the transfer is complete. The response + * byte sent to from the attached SPI device is ignored. + * + * \param[in,out] SPI Pointer to the base of the SPI peripheral within the device. + * \param[in] Byte Byte to send through the SPI interface. + */ + static inline void SPI_SendByte(SPI_t* const SPI, + const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void SPI_SendByte(SPI_t* const SPI, + const uint8_t Byte) + { + SPI->DATA = Byte; + while (!(SPI->STATUS & SPI_IF_bm)); + } + + /** Sends a dummy byte through the SPI interface, blocking until the transfer is complete. The response + * byte from the attached SPI device is returned. + * + * \param[in,out] SPI Pointer to the base of the SPI peripheral within the device. + * + * \return The response byte from the attached SPI device. + */ + static inline uint8_t SPI_ReceiveByte(SPI_t* const SPI) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline uint8_t SPI_ReceiveByte(SPI_t* const SPI) + { + SPI->DATA = 0; + while (!(SPI->STATUS & SPI_IF_bm)); + return SPI->DATA; + } + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/SerialSPI_XMEGA.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/SerialSPI_XMEGA.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ca3235083c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/SerialSPI_XMEGA.h @@ -0,0 +1,212 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Master SPI Mode Serial USART Peripheral Driver (XMEGA) + * + * On-chip Master SPI mode USART driver for the XMEGA AVR microcontrollers. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the SPI Master + * Mode USART driver dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_SerialSPI + * \defgroup Group_SerialSPI_XMEGA Master SPI Mode Serial USART Peripheral Driver (XMEGA) + * + * \section Sec_SerialSPI_XMEGA_ModDescription Module Description + * On-chip serial USART driver for the XMEGA AVR microcontrollers. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the ADC driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SerialSPI.h. + * + * \section Sec_SerialSPI_XMEGA_ExampleUsage Example Usage + * The following snippet is an example of how this module may be used within a typical + * application. + * + * \code + * // Initialize the Master SPI mode USART driver before first use, with 1Mbit baud + * SerialSPI_Init(&USARTD0, (USART_SPI_SCK_LEAD_RISING | USART_SPI_SAMPLE_LEADING | USART_SPI_ORDER_MSB_FIRST), 1000000); + * + * // Send several bytes, ignoring the returned data + * SerialSPI_SendByte(&USARTD0, 0x01); + * SerialSPI_SendByte(&USARTD0, 0x02); + * SerialSPI_SendByte(&USARTD0, 0x03); + * + * // Receive several bytes, sending a dummy 0x00 byte each time + * uint8_t Byte1 = SerialSPI_ReceiveByte(&USARTD); + * uint8_t Byte2 = SerialSPI_ReceiveByte(&USARTD); + * uint8_t Byte3 = SerialSPI_ReceiveByte(&USARTD); + * + * // Send a byte, and store the received byte from the same transaction + * uint8_t ResponseByte = SerialSPI_TransferByte(&USARTD0, 0xDC); + * \endcode + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __SERIAL_SPI_XMEGA_H__ +#define __SERIAL_SPI_XMEGA_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + + #include <stdio.h> + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_SERIAL_SPI_H) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #define SERIAL_SPI_UBBRVAL(Baud) ((Baud < (F_CPU / 2)) ? ((F_CPU / (2 * Baud)) - 1) : 0) + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** \name SPI SCK Polarity Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** SPI clock polarity mask for \ref SerialSPI_Init(). Indicates that the SCK should lead on the rising edge. */ + #define USART_SPI_SCK_LEAD_RISING 0 + //@} + + /** \name SPI Sample Edge Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** SPI data sample mode mask for \ref SerialSPI_Init(). Indicates that the data should sampled on the leading edge. */ + #define USART_SPI_SAMPLE_LEADING 0 + + /** SPI data sample mode mask for \ref SerialSPI_Init(). Indicates that the data should be sampled on the trailing edge. */ + #define USART_SPI_SAMPLE_TRAILING (1 << 1) + //@} + + /** \name SPI Data Ordering Configuration Masks */ + //@{ + /** SPI data order mask for \ref SerialSPI_Init(). Indicates that data should be shifted out MSB first. */ + #define USART_SPI_ORDER_MSB_FIRST 0 + + /** SPI data order mask for \ref SerialSPI_Init(). Indicates that data should be shifted out LSB first. */ + #define USART_SPI_ORDER_LSB_FIRST (1 << 2) + //@} + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initialize the USART module in Master SPI mode. + * + * \param[in,out] USART Pointer to the base of the USART peripheral within the device. + * \param[in] SPIOptions USART SPI Options, a mask consisting of one of each of the \c USART_SPI_SCK_*, + * \c USART_SPI_SAMPLE_* and \c USART_SPI_ORDER_* masks. + * \param[in] BaudRate SPI baud rate, in bits per second. + */ + static inline void SerialSPI_Init(USART_t* const USART, + const uint8_t SPIOptions, + const uint32_t BaudRate) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void SerialSPI_Init(USART_t* const USART, + const uint8_t SPIOptions, + const uint32_t BaudRate) + { + uint16_t BaudValue = SERIAL_SPI_UBBRVAL(BaudRate); + + USART->BAUDCTRLB = (BaudValue >> 8); + USART->BAUDCTRLA = (BaudValue & 0xFF); + + USART->CTRLC = (USART_CMODE_MSPI_gc | SPIOptions); + USART->CTRLB = (USART_RXEN_bm | USART_TXEN_bm); + } + + /** Turns off the USART driver, disabling and returning used hardware to their default configuration. + * + * \param[in,out] USART Pointer to the base of the USART peripheral within the device. + */ + static inline void SerialSPI_Disable(USART_t* const USART) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void SerialSPI_Disable(USART_t* const USART) + { + USART->CTRLA = 0; + USART->CTRLB = 0; + USART->CTRLC = 0; + } + + /** Sends and receives a byte through the USART SPI interface, blocking until the transfer is complete. + * + * \param[in,out] USART Pointer to the base of the USART peripheral within the device. + * \param[in] DataByte Byte to send through the USART SPI interface. + * + * \return Response byte from the attached SPI device. + */ + static inline uint8_t SerialSPI_TransferByte(USART_t* const USART, + const uint8_t DataByte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline uint8_t SerialSPI_TransferByte(USART_t* const USART, + const uint8_t DataByte) + { + USART->DATA = DataByte; + while (!(USART->STATUS & USART_TXCIF_bm)); + USART->STATUS = USART_TXCIF_bm; + return USART->DATA; + } + + /** Sends a byte through the USART SPI interface, blocking until the transfer is complete. The response + * byte sent to from the attached SPI device is ignored. + * + * \param[in,out] USART Pointer to the base of the USART peripheral within the device. + * \param[in] DataByte Byte to send through the USART SPI interface. + */ + static inline void SerialSPI_SendByte(USART_t* const USART, + const uint8_t DataByte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void SerialSPI_SendByte(USART_t* const USART, + const uint8_t DataByte) + { + SerialSPI_TransferByte(USART, DataByte); + } + + /** Sends a dummy byte through the USART SPI interface, blocking until the transfer is complete. The response + * byte from the attached SPI device is returned. + * + * \param[in,out] USART Pointer to the base of the USART peripheral within the device. + * + * \return The response byte from the attached SPI device. + */ + static inline uint8_t SerialSPI_ReceiveByte(USART_t* const USART) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline uint8_t SerialSPI_ReceiveByte(USART_t* const USART) + { + return SerialSPI_TransferByte(USART, 0); + } + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/Serial_XMEGA.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/Serial_XMEGA.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9ecda47d2d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/Serial_XMEGA.c @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_SERIAL_C +#include "../Serial.h" + +FILE USARTSerialStream; + +int Serial_putchar(char DataByte, + FILE *Stream) +{ + USART_t* USART = fdev_get_udata(Stream); + + Serial_SendByte(USART, DataByte); + return 0; +} + +int Serial_getchar(FILE *Stream) +{ + USART_t* USART = fdev_get_udata(Stream); + + if (!(Serial_IsCharReceived(USART))) + return _FDEV_EOF; + + return Serial_ReceiveByte(USART); +} + +int Serial_getchar_Blocking(FILE *Stream) +{ + USART_t* USART = fdev_get_udata(Stream); + + while (!(Serial_IsCharReceived(USART))); + return Serial_ReceiveByte(USART); +} + +void Serial_SendString_P(USART_t* const USART, + const char* FlashStringPtr) +{ + uint8_t CurrByte; + + while ((CurrByte = pgm_read_byte(FlashStringPtr)) != 0x00) + { + Serial_SendByte(USART, CurrByte); + FlashStringPtr++; + } +} + +void Serial_SendString(USART_t* const USART, + const char* StringPtr) +{ + uint8_t CurrByte; + + while ((CurrByte = *StringPtr) != 0x00) + { + Serial_SendByte(USART, CurrByte); + StringPtr++; + } +} + +void Serial_SendData(USART_t* const USART, + const void* Buffer, + uint16_t Length) +{ + uint8_t* CurrByte = (uint8_t*)Buffer; + + while (Length--) + Serial_SendByte(USART, *(CurrByte++)); +} + +void Serial_CreateStream(USART_t* USART, FILE* Stream) +{ + if (!(Stream)) + { + Stream = &USARTSerialStream; + stdin = Stream; + stdout = Stream; + } + + *Stream = (FILE)FDEV_SETUP_STREAM(Serial_putchar, Serial_getchar, _FDEV_SETUP_RW); + fdev_set_udata(Stream, USART); +} + +void Serial_CreateBlockingStream(USART_t* USART, FILE* Stream) +{ + if (!(Stream)) + { + Stream = &USARTSerialStream; + stdin = Stream; + stdout = Stream; + } + + *Stream = (FILE)FDEV_SETUP_STREAM(Serial_putchar, Serial_getchar_Blocking, _FDEV_SETUP_RW); + fdev_set_udata(Stream, USART); +} + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/Serial_XMEGA.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/Serial_XMEGA.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..36f507d43e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/Serial_XMEGA.h @@ -0,0 +1,289 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Serial USART Peripheral Driver (XMEGA) + * + * On-chip serial USART driver for the XMEGA AVR microcontrollers. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USART driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Serial + * \defgroup Group_Serial_XMEGA Serial USART Peripheral Driver (XMEGA) + * + * \section Sec_Serial_XMEGA_ModDescription Module Description + * On-chip serial USART driver for the XMEGA AVR microcontrollers. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USART driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h. + * + * \section Sec_Serial_XMEGA_ExampleUsage Example Usage + * The following snippet is an example of how this module may be used within a typical + * application. + * + * \code + * // Initialize the serial USART driver before first use, with 9600 baud (and no double-speed mode) + * Serial_Init(&USARTD0, 9600, false); + * + * // Send a string through the USART + * Serial_TxString(&USARTD0, "Test String\r\n"); + * + * // Receive a byte through the USART + * uint8_t DataByte = Serial_RxByte(&USARTD0); + * \endcode + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __SERIAL_XMEGA_H__ +#define __SERIAL_XMEGA_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../../Misc/TerminalCodes.h" + + #include <stdio.h> + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_SERIAL_H) && !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_SERIAL_C) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* External Variables: */ + extern FILE USARTSerialStream; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + int Serial_putchar(char DataByte, + FILE *Stream); + int Serial_getchar(FILE *Stream); + int Serial_getchar_Blocking(FILE *Stream); + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Macro for calculating the baud value from a given baud rate when the \c U2X (double speed) bit is + * not set. + * + * \param[in] Baud Target serial UART baud rate. + * + * \return Closest UBRR register value for the given UART frequency. + */ + #define SERIAL_UBBRVAL(Baud) ((((F_CPU / 16) + (Baud / 2)) / (Baud)) - 1) + + /** Macro for calculating the baud value from a given baud rate when the \c U2X (double speed) bit is + * set. + * + * \param[in] Baud Target serial UART baud rate. + * + * \return Closest UBRR register value for the given UART frequency. + */ + #define SERIAL_2X_UBBRVAL(Baud) ((((F_CPU / 8) + (Baud / 2)) / (Baud)) - 1) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Transmits a given string located in program space (FLASH) through the USART. + * + * \param[in,out] USART Pointer to the base of the USART peripheral within the device. + * \param[in] FlashStringPtr Pointer to a string located in program space. + */ + void Serial_SendString_P(USART_t* const USART, + const char* FlashStringPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Transmits a given string located in SRAM memory through the USART. + * + * \param[in,out] USART Pointer to the base of the USART peripheral within the device. + * \param[in] StringPtr Pointer to a string located in SRAM space. + */ + void Serial_SendString(USART_t* const USART, + const char* StringPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Transmits a given buffer located in SRAM memory through the USART. + * + * \param[in,out] USART Pointer to the base of the USART peripheral within the device. + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to a buffer containing the data to send. + * \param[in] Length Length of the data to send, in bytes. + */ + void Serial_SendData(USART_t* const USART, + const void* Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Creates a standard character stream from the USART so that it can be used with all the regular functions + * in the avr-libc \c <stdio.h> library that accept a \c FILE stream as a destination (e.g. \c fprintf). The created + * stream is bidirectional and can be used for both input and output functions. + * + * Reading data from this stream is non-blocking, i.e. in most instances, complete strings cannot be read in by a single + * fetch, as the endpoint will not be ready at some point in the transmission, aborting the transfer. However, this may + * be used when the read data is processed byte-per-bye (via \c getc()) or when the user application will implement its own + * line buffering. + * + * \param[in,out] USART Pointer to the base of the USART peripheral within the device. + * \param[in,out] Stream Pointer to a FILE structure where the created stream should be placed, if \c NULL, \c stdout + * and \c stdin will be configured to use the USART. + * + * \pre The USART must first be configured via a call to \ref Serial_Init() before the stream is used. + */ + void Serial_CreateStream(USART_t* USART, FILE* Stream); + + /** Identical to \ref Serial_CreateStream(), except that reads are blocking until the calling stream function terminates + * the transfer. + * + * \param[in,out] USART Pointer to the base of the USART peripheral within the device. + * \param[in,out] Stream Pointer to a FILE structure where the created stream should be placed, if \c NULL, \c stdout + * and \c stdin will be configured to use the USART. + * + * \pre The USART must first be configured via a call to \ref Serial_Init() before the stream is used. + */ + void Serial_CreateBlockingStream(USART_t* USART, FILE* Stream); + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initializes the USART, ready for serial data transmission and reception. This initializes the interface to + * standard 8-bit, no parity, 1 stop bit settings suitable for most applications. + * + * \param[in,out] USART Pointer to the base of the USART peripheral within the device. + * \param[in] BaudRate Serial baud rate, in bits per second. This should be the target baud rate regardless of + * the \c DoubleSpeed parameter's value. + * \param[in] DoubleSpeed Enables double speed mode when set, halving the sample time to double the baud rate. + */ + static inline void Serial_Init(USART_t* const USART, + const uint32_t BaudRate, + const bool DoubleSpeed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void Serial_Init(USART_t* const USART, + const uint32_t BaudRate, + const bool DoubleSpeed) + { + uint16_t BaudValue = (DoubleSpeed ? SERIAL_2X_UBBRVAL(BaudRate) : SERIAL_UBBRVAL(BaudRate)); + + USART->BAUDCTRLB = (BaudValue >> 8); + USART->BAUDCTRLA = (BaudValue & 0xFF); + + USART->CTRLC = (USART_CMODE_ASYNCHRONOUS_gc | USART_PMODE_DISABLED_gc | USART_CHSIZE_8BIT_gc); + USART->CTRLB = (USART_RXEN_bm | USART_TXEN_bm | (DoubleSpeed ? USART_CLK2X_bm : 0)); + } + + /** Turns off the USART driver, disabling and returning used hardware to their default configuration. + * + * \param[in,out] USART Pointer to the base of the USART peripheral within the device. + */ + static inline void Serial_Disable(USART_t* const USART) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void Serial_Disable(USART_t* const USART) + { + USART->CTRLA = 0; + USART->CTRLB = 0; + USART->CTRLC = 0; + } + + /** Indicates whether a character has been received through the USART. + * + * \param[in,out] USART Pointer to the base of the USART peripheral within the device. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if a character has been received, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Serial_IsCharReceived(USART_t* const USART) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline bool Serial_IsCharReceived(USART_t* const USART) + { + return ((USART->STATUS & USART_RXCIF_bm) ? true : false); + } + + /** Indicates whether there is hardware buffer space for a new transmit on the USART. This + * function can be used to determine if a call to \ref Serial_SendByte() will block in advance. + * + * \param[in,out] USART Pointer to the base of the USART peripheral within the device. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if a character can be queued for transmission immediately, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Serial_IsSendReady(USART_t* const USART) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline bool Serial_IsSendReady(USART_t* const USART) + { + return (USART->STATUS & USART_DREIF_bm) ? true : false; + } + + /** Indicates whether the hardware USART transmit buffer is completely empty, indicating all + * pending transmissions have completed. + * + * \param[in,out] USART Pointer to the base of the USART peripheral within the device. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if no characters are buffered for transmission, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Serial_IsSendComplete(USART_t* const USART) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline bool Serial_IsSendComplete(USART_t* const USART) + { + return (USART->STATUS & USART_TXCIF_bm) ? true : false; + } + + /** Transmits a given byte through the USART. + * + * \note If no buffer space is available in the hardware USART, this function will block. To check if + * space is available before calling this function, see \ref Serial_IsSendReady(). + * + * \param[in,out] USART Pointer to the base of the USART peripheral within the device. + * \param[in] DataByte Byte to transmit through the USART. + */ + static inline void Serial_SendByte(USART_t* const USART, + const char DataByte) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void Serial_SendByte(USART_t* const USART, + const char DataByte) + { + while (!(Serial_IsSendReady(USART))); + USART->DATA = DataByte; + } + + /** Receives the next byte from the USART. + * + * \param[in,out] USART Pointer to the base of the USART peripheral within the device. + * + * \return Next byte received from the USART, or a negative value if no byte has been received. + */ + static inline int16_t Serial_ReceiveByte(USART_t* const USART) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline int16_t Serial_ReceiveByte(USART_t* const USART) + { + if (!(Serial_IsCharReceived(USART))) + return -1; + + USART->STATUS = USART_RXCIF_bm; + return USART->DATA; + } + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/TWI_XMEGA.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/TWI_XMEGA.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..92cc643b9e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/TWI_XMEGA.c @@ -0,0 +1,185 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_TWI_C +#include "../TWI.h" + +uint8_t TWI_StartTransmission(TWI_t* const TWI, + const uint8_t SlaveAddress, + const uint8_t TimeoutMS) +{ + uint16_t TimeoutRemaining; + + TWI->MASTER.ADDR = SlaveAddress; + + TimeoutRemaining = (TimeoutMS * 100); + while (TimeoutRemaining) + { + uint8_t status = TWI->MASTER.STATUS; + + if ((status & (TWI_MASTER_WIF_bm | TWI_MASTER_ARBLOST_bm)) == (TWI_MASTER_WIF_bm | TWI_MASTER_ARBLOST_bm)) + { + TWI->MASTER.ADDR = SlaveAddress; + } + else if ((status & (TWI_MASTER_WIF_bm | TWI_MASTER_RXACK_bm)) == (TWI_MASTER_WIF_bm | TWI_MASTER_RXACK_bm)) + { + TWI_StopTransmission(TWI); + return TWI_ERROR_SlaveResponseTimeout; + } + else if (status & (TWI_MASTER_WIF_bm | TWI_MASTER_RIF_bm)) + { + return TWI_ERROR_NoError; + } + + _delay_us(10); + TimeoutRemaining--; + } + + if (!(TimeoutRemaining)) { + if (TWI->MASTER.STATUS & TWI_MASTER_CLKHOLD_bm) { + TWI_StopTransmission(TWI); + } + } + + return TWI_ERROR_BusCaptureTimeout; +} + +bool TWI_SendByte(TWI_t* const TWI, + const uint8_t Byte) +{ + TWI->MASTER.DATA = Byte; + + while (!(TWI->MASTER.STATUS & TWI_MASTER_WIF_bm)); + + return (TWI->MASTER.STATUS & TWI_MASTER_WIF_bm) && !(TWI->MASTER.STATUS & TWI_MASTER_RXACK_bm); +} + +bool TWI_ReceiveByte(TWI_t* const TWI, + uint8_t* const Byte, + const bool LastByte) +{ + if ((TWI->MASTER.STATUS & (TWI_MASTER_BUSERR_bm | TWI_MASTER_ARBLOST_bm)) == (TWI_MASTER_BUSERR_bm | TWI_MASTER_ARBLOST_bm)) { + return false; + } + + while (!(TWI->MASTER.STATUS & TWI_MASTER_RIF_bm)); + + *Byte = TWI->MASTER.DATA; + + if (LastByte) + TWI->MASTER.CTRLC = TWI_MASTER_ACKACT_bm | TWI_MASTER_CMD_STOP_gc; + else + TWI->MASTER.CTRLC = TWI_MASTER_CMD_RECVTRANS_gc; + + return true; +} + +uint8_t TWI_ReadPacket(TWI_t* const TWI, + const uint8_t SlaveAddress, + const uint8_t TimeoutMS, + const uint8_t* InternalAddress, + uint8_t InternalAddressLen, + uint8_t* Buffer, + uint16_t Length) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((ErrorCode = TWI_StartTransmission(TWI, (SlaveAddress & TWI_DEVICE_ADDRESS_MASK) | TWI_ADDRESS_WRITE, + TimeoutMS)) == TWI_ERROR_NoError) + { + while (InternalAddressLen--) + { + if (!(TWI_SendByte(TWI, *(InternalAddress++)))) + { + ErrorCode = TWI_ERROR_SlaveNAK; + break; + } + } + + if ((ErrorCode = TWI_StartTransmission(TWI, (SlaveAddress & TWI_DEVICE_ADDRESS_MASK) | TWI_ADDRESS_READ, + TimeoutMS)) == TWI_ERROR_NoError) + { + while (Length--) + { + if (!(TWI_ReceiveByte(TWI, Buffer++, (Length == 0)))) + { + ErrorCode = TWI_ERROR_SlaveNAK; + break; + } + } + } + + TWI_StopTransmission(TWI); + } + + return ErrorCode; +} + +uint8_t TWI_WritePacket(TWI_t* const TWI, + const uint8_t SlaveAddress, + const uint8_t TimeoutMS, + const uint8_t* InternalAddress, + uint8_t InternalAddressLen, + const uint8_t* Buffer, + uint16_t Length) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((ErrorCode = TWI_StartTransmission(TWI, (SlaveAddress & TWI_DEVICE_ADDRESS_MASK) | TWI_ADDRESS_WRITE, + TimeoutMS)) == TWI_ERROR_NoError) + { + while (InternalAddressLen--) + { + if (!(TWI_SendByte(TWI, *(InternalAddress++)))) + { + ErrorCode = TWI_ERROR_SlaveNAK; + break; + } + } + + while (Length--) + { + if (!(TWI_SendByte(TWI, *(Buffer++)))) + { + ErrorCode = TWI_ERROR_SlaveNAK; + break; + } + } + + TWI_StopTransmission(TWI); + } + + return ErrorCode; +} + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/TWI_XMEGA.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/TWI_XMEGA.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..94ada73719 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/TWI_XMEGA.h @@ -0,0 +1,302 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief TWI Peripheral Driver (XMEGA) + * + * On-chip TWI driver for the XMEGA Family of AVR microcontrollers. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the TWI driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/TWI.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_TWI + * \defgroup Group_TWI_XMEGA TWI Peripheral Driver (XMEGA) + * + * \section Sec_TWI_XMEGA_ModDescription Module Description + * Master mode TWI driver for the 8-bit AVR microcontrollers which contain a hardware TWI module. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the TWI driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/TWI.h. + * + * \section Sec_TWI_XMEGA_ExampleUsage Example Usage + * The following snippet is an example of how this module may be used within a typical + * application. + * + * <b>Low Level API Example:</b> + * \code + * // Initialize the TWI driver before first use at 200KHz + * TWI_Init(&TWIC, TWI_BAUD_FROM_FREQ(200000)); + * + * // Start a write session to device at device address 0xA0, internal address 0xDC with a 10ms timeout + * if (TWI_StartTransmission(&TWIC, 0xA0 | TWI_ADDRESS_WRITE, 10) == TWI_ERROR_NoError) + * { + * TWI_SendByte(&TWIC, 0xDC); + * + * TWI_SendByte(&TWIC, 0x01); + * TWI_SendByte(&TWIC, 0x02); + * TWI_SendByte(&TWIC, 0x03); + * + * // Must stop transmission afterwards to release the bus + * TWI_StopTransmission(&TWIC); + * } + * + * // Start a read session to device at address 0xA0, internal address 0xDC with a 10ms timeout + * if (TWI_StartTransmission(&TWIC, 0xA0 | TWI_ADDRESS_WRITE, 10) == TWI_ERROR_NoError) + * { + * TWI_SendByte(&TWIC, 0xDC); + * TWI_StopTransmission(&TWIC); + * + * if (TWI_StartTransmission(&TWIC, 0xA0 | TWI_ADDRESS_READ, 10) == TWI_ERROR_NoError) + * { + * uint8_t Byte1, Byte2, Byte3; + * + * // Read three bytes, acknowledge after the third byte is received + * TWI_ReceiveByte(&TWIC, &Byte1, false); + * TWI_ReceiveByte(&TWIC, &Byte2, false); + * TWI_ReceiveByte(&TWIC, &Byte3, true); + * + * // Must stop transmission afterwards to release the bus + * TWI_StopTransmission(&TWIC); + * } + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>High Level API Example:</b> + * \code + * // Initialize the TWI driver before first use at 200KHz + * TWI_Init(&TWIC, TWI_BAUD_FROM_FREQ(200000)); + * + * // Start a write session to device at device address 0xA0, internal address 0xDC with a 10ms timeout + * uint8_t InternalWriteAddress = 0xDC; + * uint8_t WritePacket[3] = {0x01, 0x02, 0x03}; + * + * TWI_WritePacket(&TWIC, 0xA0, 10, &InternalWriteAddress, sizeof(InternalWriteAddress), + * &WritePacket, sizeof(WritePacket); + * + * // Start a read session to device at address 0xA0, internal address 0xDC with a 10ms timeout + * uint8_t InternalReadAddress = 0xDC; + * uint8_t ReadPacket[3]; + * + * TWI_ReadPacket(&TWIC, 0xA0, 10, &InternalReadAddress, sizeof(InternalReadAddress), + * &ReadPacket, sizeof(ReadPacket); + * \endcode + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __TWI_XMEGA_H__ +#define __TWI_XMEGA_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + + #include <stdio.h> + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_TWI_H) && !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_TWI_C) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/TWI.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** TWI slave device address mask for a read session. Mask with a slave device base address to obtain + * the correct TWI bus address for the slave device when reading data from it. + */ + #define TWI_ADDRESS_READ 0x01 + + /** TWI slave device address mask for a write session. Mask with a slave device base address to obtain + * the correct TWI bus address for the slave device when writing data to it. + */ + #define TWI_ADDRESS_WRITE 0x00 + + /** Mask to retrieve the base address for a TWI device, which can then be ORed with \ref TWI_ADDRESS_READ + * or \ref TWI_ADDRESS_WRITE to obtain the device's read and write address respectively. + */ + #define TWI_DEVICE_ADDRESS_MASK 0xFE + + /** Calculates the length of each bit on the TWI bus for a given target frequency. This may be used with + * the \ref TWI_Init() function to convert a bus frequency to a number of clocks for the \c BitLength + * parameter. + * + * \param[in] Frequency Desired TWI bus frequency in Hz. + * + * \return Bit length in clocks for the given TWI bus frequency at the given prescaler value. + */ + #define TWI_BAUD_FROM_FREQ(Frequency) ((F_CPU / (2 * Frequency)) - 5) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the TWI transfer start routine and other dependant TWI functions. */ + enum TWI_ErrorCodes_t + { + TWI_ERROR_NoError = 0, /**< Indicates that the command completed successfully. */ + TWI_ERROR_BusFault = 1, /**< A TWI bus fault occurred while attempting to capture the bus. */ + TWI_ERROR_BusCaptureTimeout = 2, /**< A timeout occurred whilst waiting for the bus to be ready. */ + TWI_ERROR_SlaveResponseTimeout = 3, /**< No ACK received at the nominated slave address within the timeout period. */ + TWI_ERROR_SlaveNotReady = 4, /**< Slave NAKed the TWI bus START condition. */ + TWI_ERROR_SlaveNAK = 5, /**< Slave NAKed whilst attempting to send data to the device. */ + }; + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initializes the TWI hardware into master mode, ready for data transmission and reception. This must be + * before any other TWI operations. + * + * The generated SCL frequency will be according to the formula <pre>F_CPU / (2 * (5 + (BAUD)))</pre>. + * + * \attention The value of the \c BitLength parameter should not be set below 10 or invalid bus conditions may + * occur, as indicated in the XMEGA microcontroller datasheet. + * + * \param[in] TWI Pointer to the base of the TWI peripheral within the device. + * \param[in] Baud Value of the BAUD register of the TWI Master. + */ + static inline void TWI_Init(TWI_t* const TWI, + const uint8_t Baud) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void TWI_Init(TWI_t* const TWI, + const uint8_t Baud) + { + TWI->CTRL = 0x00; + TWI->MASTER.BAUD = Baud; + TWI->MASTER.CTRLA = TWI_MASTER_ENABLE_bm; + TWI->MASTER.CTRLB = 0; + TWI->MASTER.STATUS = TWI_MASTER_BUSSTATE_IDLE_gc; + } + + /** Turns off the TWI driver hardware. If this is called, any further TWI operations will require a call to + * \ref TWI_Init() before the TWI can be used again. + * + * \param[in] TWI Pointer to the base of the TWI peripheral within the device. + */ + static inline void TWI_Disable(TWI_t* const TWI) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void TWI_Disable(TWI_t* const TWI) + { + TWI->MASTER.CTRLA &= ~TWI_MASTER_ENABLE_bm; + } + + /** Sends a TWI STOP onto the TWI bus, terminating communication with the currently addressed device. + * + * \param[in] TWI Pointer to the base of the TWI peripheral within the device. + */ + static inline void TWI_StopTransmission(TWI_t* const TWI) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void TWI_StopTransmission(TWI_t* const TWI) + { + TWI->MASTER.CTRLC = TWI_MASTER_ACKACT_bm | TWI_MASTER_CMD_STOP_gc; + } + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Begins a master mode TWI bus communication with the given slave device address. + * + * \param[in] TWI Pointer to the base of the TWI peripheral within the device. + * \param[in] SlaveAddress Address of the slave TWI device to communicate with. + * \param[in] TimeoutMS Timeout period within which the slave must respond, in milliseconds. + * + * \return A value from the \ref TWI_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t TWI_StartTransmission(TWI_t* const TWI, + const uint8_t SlaveAddress, + const uint8_t TimeoutMS) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sends a byte to the currently addressed device on the TWI bus. + * + * \param[in] TWI Pointer to the base of the TWI peripheral within the device. + * \param[in] Byte Byte to send to the currently addressed device + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the recipient ACKed the byte, \c false otherwise + */ + bool TWI_SendByte(TWI_t* const TWI, + const uint8_t Byte) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Receives a byte from the currently addressed device on the TWI bus. + * + * \param[in] TWI Pointer to the base of the TWI peripheral within the device. + * \param[in] Byte Location where the read byte is to be stored. + * \param[in] LastByte Indicates if the byte should be ACKed if false, NAKed if true. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the byte reception successfully completed, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool TWI_ReceiveByte(TWI_t* const TWI, + uint8_t* const Byte, + const bool LastByte) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** High level function to perform a complete packet transfer over the TWI bus to the specified + * device. + * + * \param[in] TWI Pointer to the base of the TWI peripheral within the device. + * \param[in] SlaveAddress Base address of the TWI slave device to communicate with. + * \param[in] TimeoutMS Timeout for bus capture and slave START ACK, in milliseconds. + * \param[in] InternalAddress Pointer to a location where the internal slave read start address is stored. + * \param[in] InternalAddressLen Size of the internal device address, in bytes. + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to a buffer where the read packet data is to be stored. + * \param[in] Length Size of the packet to read, in bytes. + * + * \return A value from the \ref TWI_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t TWI_ReadPacket(TWI_t* const TWI, + const uint8_t SlaveAddress, + const uint8_t TimeoutMS, + const uint8_t* InternalAddress, + uint8_t InternalAddressLen, + uint8_t* Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(4); + + /** High level function to perform a complete packet transfer over the TWI bus from the specified + * device. + * + * \param[in] TWI Pointer to the base of the TWI peripheral within the device. + * \param[in] SlaveAddress Base address of the TWI slave device to communicate with + * \param[in] TimeoutMS Timeout for bus capture and slave START ACK, in milliseconds + * \param[in] InternalAddress Pointer to a location where the internal slave write start address is stored + * \param[in] InternalAddressLen Size of the internal device address, in bytes + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to a buffer where the packet data to send is stored + * \param[in] Length Size of the packet to send, in bytes + * + * \return A value from the \ref TWI_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t TWI_WritePacket(TWI_t* const TWI, + const uint8_t SlaveAddress, + const uint8_t TimeoutMS, + const uint8_t* InternalAddress, + uint8_t InternalAddressLen, + const uint8_t* Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(4); + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/AndroidAccessoryClass.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/AndroidAccessoryClass.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f1c0109ea0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/AndroidAccessoryClass.h @@ -0,0 +1,77 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Master include file for the library USB Android Open Accessory Class driver. + * + * Master include file for the library USB Android Open Accessory Class driver, for both host and device modes, where available. + * + * This file should be included in all user projects making use of this optional class driver, instead of + * including any headers in the USB/ClassDriver/Device, USB/ClassDriver/Host or USB/ClassDriver/Common subdirectories. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassDrivers + * \defgroup Group_USBClassAOA Android Open Accessory Class Driver + * \brief USB class driver for the Google Android Open Accessory class standard. + * + * \section Sec_USBClassAOA_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AndroidAccessoryClassHost.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassAOA_ModDescription Module Description + * Android Open Accessory Class Driver module. This module contains an internal implementation of the USB Android Open Accessory + * Class, for Host USB mode. User applications can use this class driver instead of implementing the Android Open Accessory Class + * manually via the low-level LUFA APIs. + * + * This module is designed to simplify the user code by exposing only the required interface needed to interface with + * Host using the USB Android Open Accessory Class. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _AOA_CLASS_H_ +#define _AOA_CLASS_H_ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_AOA_DRIVER + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../Core/USBMode.h" + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + #include "Host/AndroidAccessoryClassHost.h" + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/AudioClass.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/AudioClass.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d6ced05dc6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/AudioClass.h @@ -0,0 +1,81 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Master include file for the library USB Audio 1.0 Class driver. + * + * Master include file for the library USB Audio 1.0 Class driver, for both host and device modes, where available. + * + * This file should be included in all user projects making use of this optional class driver, instead of + * including any headers in the USB/ClassDriver/Device, USB/ClassDriver/Host or USB/ClassDriver/Common subdirectories. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassDrivers + * \defgroup Group_USBClassAudio Audio 1.0 Class Driver + * \brief USB class driver for the USB-IF Audio 1.0 class standard. + * + * \section Sec_USBClassAudio_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/AudioClassDevice.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AudioClassHost.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassAudio_ModDescription Module Description + * Audio 1.0 Class Driver module. This module contains an internal implementation of the USB Audio 1.0 Class, for both + * Device and Host USB modes. User applications can use this class driver instead of implementing the Audio 1.0 class + * manually via the low-level LUFA APIs. + * + * This module is designed to simplify the user code by exposing only the required interface needed to interface with + * Hosts or Devices using the USB Audio 1.0 Class. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _AUDIO_CLASS_H_ +#define _AUDIO_CLASS_H_ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_AUDIO_DRIVER + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../Core/USBMode.h" + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + #include "Device/AudioClassDevice.h" + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + #include "Host/AudioClassHost.h" + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/CDCClass.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/CDCClass.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..30b3ee237d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/CDCClass.h @@ -0,0 +1,81 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Master include file for the library USB CDC-ACM Class driver. + * + * Master include file for the library USB CDC Class driver, for both host and device modes, where available. + * + * This file should be included in all user projects making use of this optional class driver, instead of + * including any headers in the USB/ClassDriver/Device, USB/ClassDriver/Host or USB/ClassDriver/Common subdirectories. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassDrivers + * \defgroup Group_USBClassCDC CDC-ACM (Virtual Serial) Class Driver + * \brief USB class driver for the USB-IF CDC-ACM (Virtual Serial) class standard. + * + * \section Sec_USBClassCDC_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/CDCClassDevice.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/CDCClassHost.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassCDC_ModDescription Module Description + * CDC Class Driver module. This module contains an internal implementation of the USB CDC-ACM class Virtual Serial + * Ports, for both Device and Host USB modes. User applications can use this class driver instead of implementing the + * CDC class manually via the low-level LUFA APIs. + * + * This module is designed to simplify the user code by exposing only the required interface needed to interface with + * Hosts or Devices using the USB CDC Class. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _CDC_CLASS_H_ +#define _CDC_CLASS_H_ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_CDC_DRIVER + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../Core/USBMode.h" + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + #include "Device/CDCClassDevice.h" + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + #include "Host/CDCClassHost.h" + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/AndroidAccessoryClassCommon.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/AndroidAccessoryClassCommon.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fdf8671fc9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/AndroidAccessoryClassCommon.h @@ -0,0 +1,129 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Common definitions and declarations for the library USB Android Open Accessory Class driver. + * + * Common definitions and declarations for the library USB Android Open Accessory Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassAOA + * \defgroup Group_USBClassAOACommon Common Class Definitions + * + * \section Sec_USBClassAOACommon_ModDescription Module Description + * Constants, Types and Enum definitions that are common to both Device and Host modes for the USB + * Android Open Accessory Class. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _AOA_CLASS_COMMON_H_ +#define _AOA_CLASS_COMMON_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Core/StdDescriptors.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_AOA_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** Product ID value in a Device Descriptor to indicate an Android device in Open Accessory mode. */ + #define ANDROID_ACCESSORY_PRODUCT_ID 0x2D00 + + /** Product ID value in a Device Descriptor to indicate an Android device in Open Accessory and Android Debug mode. */ + #define ANDROID_ACCESSORY_ADB_PRODUCT_ID 0x2D01 + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for possible Class, Subclass and Protocol values of device and interface descriptors relating to the + * Android Open Accessory class. + */ + enum AOA_Descriptor_ClassSubclassProtocol_t + { + AOA_CSCP_AOADataClass = 0xFF, /**< Descriptor Class value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to the AOA data class. + */ + AOA_CSCP_AOADataSubclass = 0xFF, /**< Descriptor Subclass value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to AOA data subclass. + */ + AOA_CSCP_AOADataProtocol = 0x00, /**< Descriptor Protocol value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to the AOA data class protocol. + */ + }; + + /** Enum for the Android Open Accessory class specific control requests that can be issued by the USB bus host. */ + enum AOA_ClassRequests_t + { + AOA_REQ_GetAccessoryProtocol = 0x33, /**< Android Open Accessory control request to retrieve the device's supported Accessory Protocol version. */ + AOA_REQ_SendString = 0x34, /**< Android Open Accessory control request to set an accessory property string in the device. */ + AOA_REQ_StartAccessoryMode = 0x35, /**< Android Open Accessory control request to switch the device into Accessory mode. */ + }; + + /** Enum for the possible Android Open Accessory property string indexes. */ + enum AOA_Strings_t + { + AOA_STRING_Manufacturer = 0, /**< Index of the Manufacturer property string. */ + AOA_STRING_Model = 1, /**< Index of the Model Name property string. */ + AOA_STRING_Description = 2, /**< Index of the Description property string. */ + AOA_STRING_Version = 3, /**< Index of the Version Number property string. */ + AOA_STRING_URI = 4, /**< Index of the URI Information property string. */ + AOA_STRING_Serial = 5, /**< Index of the Serial Number property string. */ + + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + AOA_STRING_TOTAL_STRINGS + #endif + }; + + /** Enum for the possible Android Open Accessory protocol versions. */ + enum AOA_Protocols_t + { + AOA_PROTOCOL_AccessoryV1 = 0x0001, /**< Android Open Accessory version 1. */ + AOA_PROTOCOL_AccessoryV2 = 0x0002, /**< Android Open Accessory version 2. */ + }; + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/AudioClassCommon.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/AudioClassCommon.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..46ecd08587 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/AudioClassCommon.h @@ -0,0 +1,780 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Common definitions and declarations for the library USB Audio 1.0 Class driver. + * + * Common definitions and declarations for the library USB Audio 1.0 Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassAudio + * \defgroup Group_USBClassAudioCommon Common Class Definitions + * + * \section Sec_USBClassAudioCommon_ModDescription Module Description + * Constants, Types and Enum definitions that are common to both Device and Host modes for the USB + * Audio 1.0 Class. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _AUDIO_CLASS_COMMON_H_ +#define _AUDIO_CLASS_COMMON_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Core/StdDescriptors.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_AUDIO_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** \name Audio Channel Masks */ + //@{ + /** Supported channel mask for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_CHANNEL_LEFT_FRONT (1 << 0) + + /** Supported channel mask for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_CHANNEL_RIGHT_FRONT (1 << 1) + + /** Supported channel mask for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_CHANNEL_CENTER_FRONT (1 << 2) + + /** Supported channel mask for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_CHANNEL_LOW_FREQ_ENHANCE (1 << 3) + + /** Supported channel mask for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_CHANNEL_LEFT_SURROUND (1 << 4) + + /** Supported channel mask for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_CHANNEL_RIGHT_SURROUND (1 << 5) + + /** Supported channel mask for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_CHANNEL_LEFT_OF_CENTER (1 << 6) + + /** Supported channel mask for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_CHANNEL_RIGHT_OF_CENTER (1 << 7) + + /** Supported channel mask for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_CHANNEL_SURROUND (1 << 8) + + /** Supported channel mask for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_CHANNEL_SIDE_LEFT (1 << 9) + + /** Supported channel mask for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_CHANNEL_SIDE_RIGHT (1 << 10) + + /** Supported channel mask for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_CHANNEL_TOP (1 << 11) + //@} + + /** \name Audio Feature Masks */ + //@{ + /** Supported feature mask for an Audio class feature unit descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_FEATURE_MUTE (1 << 0) + + /** Supported feature mask for an Audio class feature unit descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_FEATURE_VOLUME (1 << 1) + + /** Supported feature mask for an Audio class feature unit descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_FEATURE_BASS (1 << 2) + + /** Supported feature mask for an Audio class feature unit descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_FEATURE_MID (1 << 3) + + /** Supported feature mask for an Audio class feature unit descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_FEATURE_TREBLE (1 << 4) + + /** Supported feature mask for an Audio class feature unit descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_FEATURE_GRAPHIC_EQUALIZER (1 << 5) + + /** Supported feature mask for an Audio class feature unit descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_FEATURE_AUTOMATIC_GAIN (1 << 6) + + /** Supported feature mask for an Audio class feature unit descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_FEATURE_DELAY (1 << 7) + + /** Supported feature mask for an Audio class feature unit descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_FEATURE_BASS_BOOST (1 << 8) + + /** Supported feature mask for an Audio class feature unit descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_FEATURE_BASS_LOUDNESS (1 << 9) + //@} + + /** \name Audio Terminal Types */ + //@{ + /** Terminal type constant for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_TERMINAL_UNDEFINED 0x0100 + + /** Terminal type constant for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_TERMINAL_STREAMING 0x0101 + + /** Terminal type constant for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_TERMINAL_VENDOR 0x01FF + + /** Terminal type constant for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_TERMINAL_IN_UNDEFINED 0x0200 + + /** Terminal type constant for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_TERMINAL_IN_MIC 0x0201 + + /** Terminal type constant for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_TERMINAL_IN_DESKTOP_MIC 0x0202 + + /** Terminal type constant for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_TERMINAL_IN_PERSONAL_MIC 0x0203 + + /** Terminal type constant for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_TERMINAL_IN_OMNIDIR_MIC 0x0204 + + /** Terminal type constant for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_TERMINAL_IN_MIC_ARRAY 0x0205 + + /** Terminal type constant for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_TERMINAL_IN_PROCESSING_MIC 0x0206 + + /** Terminal type constant for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_TERMINAL_IN_OUT_UNDEFINED 0x0300 + + /** Terminal type constant for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_TERMINAL_OUT_SPEAKER 0x0301 + + /** Terminal type constant for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_TERMINAL_OUT_HEADPHONES 0x0302 + + /** Terminal type constant for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_TERMINAL_OUT_HEAD_MOUNTED 0x0303 + + /** Terminal type constant for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_TERMINAL_OUT_DESKTOP 0x0304 + + /** Terminal type constant for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_TERMINAL_OUT_ROOM 0x0305 + + /** Terminal type constant for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_TERMINAL_OUT_COMMUNICATION 0x0306 + + /** Terminal type constant for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */ + #define AUDIO_TERMINAL_OUT_LOWFREQ 0x0307 + //@} + + /** Convenience macro to fill a 24-bit \ref USB_Audio_SampleFreq_t structure with the given sample rate as a 24-bit number. + * + * \param[in] freq Required audio sampling frequency in HZ + */ + #define AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ(freq) {.Byte1 = ((uint32_t)freq & 0xFF), .Byte2 = (((uint32_t)freq >> 8) & 0xFF), .Byte3 = (((uint32_t)freq >> 16) & 0xFF)} + + /** Mask for the attributes parameter of an Audio class-specific Endpoint descriptor, indicating that the endpoint + * accepts only filled endpoint packets of audio samples. + */ + #define AUDIO_EP_FULL_PACKETS_ONLY (1 << 7) + + /** Mask for the attributes parameter of an Audio class-specific Endpoint descriptor, indicating that the endpoint + * will accept partially filled endpoint packets of audio samples. + */ + #define AUDIO_EP_ACCEPTS_SMALL_PACKETS (0 << 7) + + /** Mask for the attributes parameter of an Audio class-specific Endpoint descriptor, indicating that the endpoint + * allows for sampling frequency adjustments to be made via control requests directed at the endpoint. + */ + #define AUDIO_EP_SAMPLE_FREQ_CONTROL (1 << 0) + + /** Mask for the attributes parameter of an Audio class-specific Endpoint descriptor, indicating that the endpoint + * allows for pitch adjustments to be made via control requests directed at the endpoint. + */ + #define AUDIO_EP_PITCH_CONTROL (1 << 1) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for possible Class, Subclass and Protocol values of device and interface descriptors relating to the Audio + * device class. + */ + enum Audio_Descriptor_ClassSubclassProtocol_t + { + AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass = 0x01, /**< Descriptor Class value indicating that the device or + * interface belongs to the USB Audio 1.0 class. + */ + AUDIO_CSCP_ControlSubclass = 0x01, /**< Descriptor Subclass value indicating that the device or + * interface belongs to the Audio Control subclass. + */ + AUDIO_CSCP_ControlProtocol = 0x00, /**< Descriptor Protocol value indicating that the device or + * interface belongs to the Audio Control protocol. + */ + AUDIO_CSCP_AudioStreamingSubclass = 0x02, /**< Descriptor Subclass value indicating that the device or + * interface belongs to the MIDI Streaming subclass. + */ + AUDIO_CSCP_MIDIStreamingSubclass = 0x03, /**< Descriptor Subclass value indicating that the device or + * interface belongs to the Audio streaming subclass. + */ + AUDIO_CSCP_StreamingProtocol = 0x00, /**< Descriptor Protocol value indicating that the device or + * interface belongs to the Streaming Audio protocol. + */ + }; + + /** Audio class specific interface description subtypes, for the Audio Control interface. */ + enum Audio_CSInterface_AC_SubTypes_t + { + AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header = 0x01, /**< Audio class specific control interface header. */ + AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_InputTerminal = 0x02, /**< Audio class specific control interface Input Terminal. */ + AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_OutputTerminal = 0x03, /**< Audio class specific control interface Output Terminal. */ + AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Mixer = 0x04, /**< Audio class specific control interface Mixer Unit. */ + AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Selector = 0x05, /**< Audio class specific control interface Selector Unit. */ + AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Feature = 0x06, /**< Audio class specific control interface Feature Unit. */ + AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Processing = 0x07, /**< Audio class specific control interface Processing Unit. */ + AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Extension = 0x08, /**< Audio class specific control interface Extension Unit. */ + }; + + /** Audio class specific interface description subtypes, for the Audio Streaming interface. */ + enum Audio_CSInterface_AS_SubTypes_t + { + AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_General = 0x01, /**< Audio class specific streaming interface general descriptor. */ + AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_FormatType = 0x02, /**< Audio class specific streaming interface format type descriptor. */ + AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_FormatSpecific = 0x03, /**< Audio class specific streaming interface format information descriptor. */ + }; + + /** Audio class specific endpoint description subtypes, for the Audio Streaming interface. */ + enum Audio_CSEndpoint_SubTypes_t + { + AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSEndpoint_General = 0x01, /**< Audio class specific endpoint general descriptor. */ + }; + + /** Enum for the Audio class specific control requests that can be issued by the USB bus host. */ + enum Audio_ClassRequests_t + { + AUDIO_REQ_SetCurrent = 0x01, /**< Audio class-specific request to set the current value of a parameter within the device. */ + AUDIO_REQ_SetMinimum = 0x02, /**< Audio class-specific request to set the minimum value of a parameter within the device. */ + AUDIO_REQ_SetMaximum = 0x03, /**< Audio class-specific request to set the maximum value of a parameter within the device. */ + AUDIO_REQ_SetResolution = 0x04, /**< Audio class-specific request to set the resolution value of a parameter within the device. */ + AUDIO_REQ_SetMemory = 0x05, /**< Audio class-specific request to set the memory value of a parameter within the device. */ + AUDIO_REQ_GetCurrent = 0x81, /**< Audio class-specific request to get the current value of a parameter within the device. */ + AUDIO_REQ_GetMinimum = 0x82, /**< Audio class-specific request to get the minimum value of a parameter within the device. */ + AUDIO_REQ_GetMaximum = 0x83, /**< Audio class-specific request to get the maximum value of a parameter within the device. */ + AUDIO_REQ_GetResolution = 0x84, /**< Audio class-specific request to get the resolution value of a parameter within the device. */ + AUDIO_REQ_GetMemory = 0x85, /**< Audio class-specific request to get the memory value of a parameter within the device. */ + AUDIO_REQ_GetStatus = 0xFF, /**< Audio class-specific request to get the device status. */ + }; + + /** Enum for Audio class specific Endpoint control modifiers which can be set and retrieved by a USB host, if the corresponding + * endpoint control is indicated to be supported in the Endpoint's Audio-class specific endpoint descriptor. + */ + enum Audio_EndpointControls_t + { + AUDIO_EPCONTROL_SamplingFreq = 0x01, /**< Sampling frequency adjustment of the endpoint. */ + AUDIO_EPCONTROL_Pitch = 0x02, /**< Pitch adjustment of the endpoint. */ + }; + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief Audio class-specific Input Terminal Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific input terminal descriptor. This indicates to the host that the device + * contains an input audio source, either from a physical terminal on the device, or a logical terminal (for example, + * a USB endpoint). See the USB Audio specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_Audio_StdDescriptor_InputTerminal_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length. */ + uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors, + * must be \ref AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_InputTerminal. + */ + + uint8_t TerminalID; /**< ID value of this terminal unit - must be a unique value within the device. */ + uint16_t TerminalType; /**< Type of terminal, a \c TERMINAL_* mask. */ + uint8_t AssociatedOutputTerminal; /**< ID of associated output terminal, for physically grouped terminals + * such as the speaker and microphone of a phone handset. + */ + uint8_t TotalChannels; /**< Total number of separate audio channels within this interface (right, left, etc.) */ + uint16_t ChannelConfig; /**< \c CHANNEL_* masks indicating what channel layout is supported by this terminal. */ + + uint8_t ChannelStrIndex; /**< Index of a string descriptor describing this channel within the device. */ + uint8_t TerminalStrIndex; /**< Index of a string descriptor describing this descriptor within the device. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Audio_Descriptor_InputTerminal_t; + + /** \brief Audio class-specific Input Terminal Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific input terminal descriptor. This indicates to the host that the device + * contains an input audio source, either from a physical terminal on the device, or a logical terminal (for example, + * a USB endpoint). See the USB Audio specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_Audio_Descriptor_InputTerminal_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific + * element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + + uint8_t bDescriptorSubtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors, + * must be \ref AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_InputTerminal. + */ + uint8_t bTerminalID; /**< ID value of this terminal unit - must be a unique value within the device. */ + uint16_t wTerminalType; /**< Type of terminal, a \c TERMINAL_* mask. */ + uint8_t bAssocTerminal; /**< ID of associated output terminal, for physically grouped terminals + * such as the speaker and microphone of a phone handset. + */ + uint8_t bNrChannels; /**< Total number of separate audio channels within this interface (right, left, etc.) */ + uint16_t wChannelConfig; /**< \c CHANNEL_* masks indicating what channel layout is supported by this terminal. */ + + uint8_t iChannelNames; /**< Index of a string descriptor describing this channel within the device. */ + uint8_t iTerminal; /**< Index of a string descriptor describing this descriptor within the device. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Audio_StdDescriptor_InputTerminal_t; + + /** \brief Audio class-specific Output Terminal Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific output terminal descriptor. This indicates to the host that the device + * contains an output audio sink, either to a physical terminal on the device, or a logical terminal (for example, + * a USB endpoint). See the USB Audio specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_Audio_StdDescriptor_OutputTerminal_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length. */ + uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors, + * must be \ref AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_OutputTerminal. + */ + + uint8_t TerminalID; /**< ID value of this terminal unit - must be a unique value within the device. */ + uint16_t TerminalType; /**< Type of terminal, a \c TERMINAL_* mask. */ + uint8_t AssociatedInputTerminal; /**< ID of associated input terminal, for physically grouped terminals + * such as the speaker and microphone of a phone handset. + */ + uint8_t SourceID; /**< ID value of the unit this terminal's audio is sourced from. */ + + uint8_t TerminalStrIndex; /**< Index of a string descriptor describing this descriptor within the device. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Audio_Descriptor_OutputTerminal_t; + + /** \brief Audio class-specific Output Terminal Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific output terminal descriptor. This indicates to the host that the device + * contains an output audio sink, either to a physical terminal on the device, or a logical terminal (for example, + * a USB endpoint). See the USB Audio specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_Audio_Descriptor_OutputTerminal_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific + * element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors, + * must be \ref AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_OutputTerminal. + */ + + uint8_t bDescriptorSubtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors, + * a value from the \ref Audio_CSInterface_AC_SubTypes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t bTerminalID; /**< ID value of this terminal unit - must be a unique value within the device. */ + uint16_t wTerminalType; /**< Type of terminal, a \c TERMINAL_* mask. */ + uint8_t bAssocTerminal; /**< ID of associated input terminal, for physically grouped terminals + * such as the speaker and microphone of a phone handset. + */ + uint8_t bSourceID; /**< ID value of the unit this terminal's audio is sourced from. */ + + uint8_t iTerminal; /**< Index of a string descriptor describing this descriptor within the device. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Audio_StdDescriptor_OutputTerminal_t; + + /** \brief Audio class-specific Interface Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific interface descriptor. This follows a regular interface descriptor to + * supply extra information about the audio device's layout to the host. See the USB Audio specification for more + * details. + * + * \see \ref USB_Audio_StdDescriptor_Interface_AC_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length. */ + uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors, + * a value from the \ref Audio_CSInterface_AS_SubTypes_t enum. + */ + + uint16_t ACSpecification; /**< Binary Coded Decimal value, indicating the supported Audio Class specification version. + * + * \see \ref VERSION_BCD() utility macro. + */ + uint16_t TotalLength; /**< Total length of the Audio class-specific descriptors, including this descriptor. */ + + uint8_t InCollection; /**< Total number of Audio Streaming interfaces linked to this Audio Control interface (must be 1). */ + uint8_t InterfaceNumber; /**< Interface number of the associated Audio Streaming interface. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t; + + /** \brief Audio class-specific Interface Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific interface descriptor. This follows a regular interface descriptor to + * supply extra information about the audio device's layout to the host. See the USB Audio specification for more + * details. + * + * \see \ref USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific + * element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + + uint8_t bDescriptorSubtype;/**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors, + * a value from the \ref Audio_CSInterface_AS_SubTypes_t enum. + */ + + uint16_t bcdADC; /**< Binary coded decimal value, indicating the supported Audio Class specification version. + * + * \see \ref VERSION_BCD() utility macro. + */ + uint16_t wTotalLength; /**< Total length of the Audio class-specific descriptors, including this descriptor. */ + + uint8_t bInCollection; /**< Total number of Audio Streaming interfaces linked to this Audio Control interface (must be 1). */ + uint8_t bInterfaceNumbers; /**< Interface number of the associated Audio Streaming interface. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Audio_StdDescriptor_Interface_AC_t; + + /** \brief Audio class-specific Feature Unit Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific Feature Unit descriptor. This indicates to the host what features + * are present in the device's audio stream for basic control, such as per-channel volume. See the USB Audio + * specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_Audio_StdDescriptor_FeatureUnit_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length. */ + uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors, + * must be \ref AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Feature. + */ + + uint8_t UnitID; /**< ID value of this feature unit - must be a unique value within the device. */ + uint8_t SourceID; /**< Source ID value of the audio source input into this feature unit. */ + + uint8_t ControlSize; /**< Size of each element in the \c ChannelControls array. */ + uint8_t ChannelControls[3]; /**< Feature masks for the control channel, and each separate audio channel. */ + + uint8_t FeatureUnitStrIndex; /**< Index of a string descriptor describing this descriptor within the device. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Audio_Descriptor_FeatureUnit_t; + + /** \brief Audio class-specific Feature Unit Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific Feature Unit descriptor. This indicates to the host what features + * are present in the device's audio stream for basic control, such as per-channel volume. See the USB Audio + * specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_Audio_Descriptor_FeatureUnit_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific + * element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + + uint8_t bDescriptorSubtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors, + * must be \ref AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Feature. + */ + + uint8_t bUnitID; /**< ID value of this feature unit - must be a unique value within the device. */ + uint8_t bSourceID; /**< Source ID value of the audio source input into this feature unit. */ + + uint8_t bControlSize; /**< Size of each element in the \c ChannelControls array. */ + uint8_t bmaControls[3]; /**< Feature masks for the control channel, and each separate audio channel. */ + + uint8_t iFeature; /**< Index of a string descriptor describing this descriptor within the device. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Audio_StdDescriptor_FeatureUnit_t; + + /** \brief Audio class-specific Streaming Audio Interface Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific streaming interface descriptor. This indicates to the host + * how audio streams within the device are formatted. See the USB Audio specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_Audio_StdDescriptor_Interface_AS_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length. */ + uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors, + * a value from the \ref Audio_CSInterface_AS_SubTypes_t enum. + */ + + uint8_t TerminalLink; /**< ID value of the output terminal this descriptor is describing. */ + + uint8_t FrameDelay; /**< Delay in frames resulting from the complete sample processing from input to output. */ + uint16_t AudioFormat; /**< Format of the audio stream, see Audio Device Formats specification. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AS_t; + + /** \brief Audio class-specific Streaming Audio Interface Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific streaming interface descriptor. This indicates to the host + * how audio streams within the device are formatted. See the USB Audio specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AS_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific + * element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + + uint8_t bDescriptorSubtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors, + * a value from the \ref Audio_CSInterface_AS_SubTypes_t enum. + */ + + uint8_t bTerminalLink; /**< ID value of the output terminal this descriptor is describing. */ + + uint8_t bDelay; /**< Delay in frames resulting from the complete sample processing from input to output. */ + uint16_t wFormatTag; /**< Format of the audio stream, see Audio Device Formats specification. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Audio_StdDescriptor_Interface_AS_t; + + /** \brief Audio class-specific Format Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific audio format descriptor. This is used to give the host full details + * about the number of channels, the sample resolution, acceptable sample frequencies and encoding method used + * in the device's audio streams. See the USB Audio specification for more details. + * + * \attention This descriptor <b>must</b> be followed by one or more \ref USB_Audio_SampleFreq_t elements containing + * the continuous or discrete sample frequencies. + * + * \see \ref USB_Audio_StdDescriptor_Format_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length. */ + uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors, + * must be \ref AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_FormatType. + */ + + uint8_t FormatType; /**< Format of the audio stream, see Audio Device Formats specification. */ + uint8_t Channels; /**< Total number of discrete channels in the stream. */ + + uint8_t SubFrameSize; /**< Size in bytes of each channel's sample data in the stream. */ + uint8_t BitResolution; /**< Bits of resolution of each channel's samples in the stream. */ + + uint8_t TotalDiscreteSampleRates; /**< Total number of discrete sample frequencies supported by the device. When + * zero, this must be followed by the lower and upper continuous sampling + * frequencies supported by the device; otherwise, this must be followed + * by the given number of discrete sampling frequencies supported. + */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Audio_Descriptor_Format_t; + + /** \brief 24-Bit Audio Frequency Structure. + * + * Type define for a 24-bit audio sample frequency structure. As GCC does not contain a built in 24-bit datatype, + * this this structure is used to build up the value instead. Fill this structure with the \ref AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQ() macro. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Byte1; /**< Lowest 8 bits of the 24-bit value. */ + uint8_t Byte2; /**< Middle 8 bits of the 24-bit value. */ + uint8_t Byte3; /**< Upper 8 bits of the 24-bit value. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Audio_SampleFreq_t; + + /** \brief Audio class-specific Format Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific audio format descriptor. This is used to give the host full details + * about the number of channels, the sample resolution, acceptable sample frequencies and encoding method used + * in the device's audio streams. See the USB Audio specification for more details. + * + * \attention This descriptor <b>must</b> be followed by one or more 24-bit integer elements containing the continuous + * or discrete sample frequencies. + * + * \see \ref USB_Audio_Descriptor_Format_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific + * element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors, + * must be \ref AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_FormatType. + */ + + uint8_t bDescriptorSubtype;/**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors, + * a value from the \ref Audio_CSInterface_AS_SubTypes_t enum. + */ + + uint8_t bFormatType; /**< Format of the audio stream, see Audio Device Formats specification. */ + uint8_t bNrChannels; /**< Total number of discrete channels in the stream. */ + + uint8_t bSubFrameSize; /**< Size in bytes of each channel's sample data in the stream. */ + uint8_t bBitResolution; /**< Bits of resolution of each channel's samples in the stream. */ + + uint8_t bSampleFrequencyType; /**< Total number of sample frequencies supported by the device. When + * zero, this must be followed by the lower and upper continuous sampling + * frequencies supported by the device; otherwise, this must be followed + * by the given number of discrete sampling frequencies supported. + */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Audio_StdDescriptor_Format_t; + + /** \brief Audio class-specific Streaming Endpoint Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific endpoint descriptor. This contains a regular endpoint + * descriptor with a few Audio-class-specific extensions. See the USB Audio specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_Audio_StdDescriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t Endpoint; /**< Standard endpoint descriptor describing the audio endpoint. */ + + uint8_t Refresh; /**< Always set to zero for Audio class devices. */ + uint8_t SyncEndpointNumber; /**< Endpoint address to send synchronization information to, if needed (zero otherwise). */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t; + + /** \brief Audio class-specific Streaming Endpoint Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific endpoint descriptor. This contains a regular endpoint + * descriptor with a few Audio-class-specific extensions. See the USB Audio specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific + * element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a + * value given by the specific class. + */ + uint8_t bEndpointAddress; /**< Logical address of the endpoint within the device for the current + * configuration, including direction mask. + */ + uint8_t bmAttributes; /**< Endpoint attributes, comprised of a mask of the endpoint type (\c EP_TYPE_*) + * and attributes (\c ENDPOINT_ATTR_*) masks. + */ + uint16_t wMaxPacketSize; /**< Size of the endpoint bank, in bytes. This indicates the maximum packet size + * that the endpoint can receive at a time. + */ + uint8_t bInterval; /**< Polling interval in milliseconds for the endpoint if it is an INTERRUPT or + * ISOCHRONOUS type. + */ + + uint8_t bRefresh; /**< Always set to zero for Audio class devices. */ + uint8_t bSynchAddress; /**< Endpoint address to send synchronization information to, if needed (zero otherwise). */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Audio_StdDescriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t; + + /** \brief Audio class-specific Extended Endpoint Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific extended endpoint descriptor. This contains extra information + * on the usage of endpoints used to stream audio in and out of the USB Audio device, and follows an Audio + * class-specific extended endpoint descriptor. See the USB Audio specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_Audio_StdDescriptor_StreamEndpoint_Spc_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length. */ + uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors, + * a value from the \ref Audio_CSEndpoint_SubTypes_t enum. + */ + + uint8_t Attributes; /**< Audio class-specific endpoint attributes, such as \ref AUDIO_EP_FULL_PACKETS_ONLY. */ + + uint8_t LockDelayUnits; /**< Units used for the LockDelay field, see Audio class specification. */ + uint16_t LockDelay; /**< Time required to internally lock endpoint's internal clock recovery circuitry. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Spc_t; + + /** \brief Audio class-specific Extended Endpoint Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific extended endpoint descriptor. This contains extra information + * on the usage of endpoints used to stream audio in and out of the USB Audio device, and follows an Audio + * class-specific extended endpoint descriptor. See the USB Audio specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Spc_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific + * element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + + uint8_t bDescriptorSubtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors, + * a value from the \ref Audio_CSEndpoint_SubTypes_t enum. + */ + + uint8_t bmAttributes; /**< Audio class-specific endpoint attributes, such as \ref AUDIO_EP_FULL_PACKETS_ONLY. */ + + uint8_t bLockDelayUnits; /**< Units used for the LockDelay field, see Audio class specification. */ + uint16_t wLockDelay; /**< Time required to internally lock endpoint's internal clock recovery circuitry. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Audio_StdDescriptor_StreamEndpoint_Spc_t; + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/CDCClassCommon.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/CDCClassCommon.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1ad49eca14 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/CDCClassCommon.h @@ -0,0 +1,391 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Common definitions and declarations for the library USB CDC Class driver. + * + * Common definitions and declarations for the library USB CDC Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassCDC + * \defgroup Group_USBClassCDCCommon Common Class Definitions + * + * \section Sec_USBClassCDCCommon_ModDescription Module Description + * Constants, Types and Enum definitions that are common to both Device and Host modes for the USB + * CDC Class. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _CDC_CLASS_COMMON_H_ +#define _CDC_CLASS_COMMON_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Core/StdDescriptors.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_CDC_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** \name Virtual Control Line Masks */ + //@{ + /** Mask for the DTR handshake line for use with the \ref CDC_REQ_SetControlLineState class-specific request + * from the host, to indicate that the DTR line state should be high. + */ + #define CDC_CONTROL_LINE_OUT_DTR (1 << 0) + + /** Mask for the RTS handshake line for use with the \ref CDC_REQ_SetControlLineState class-specific request + * from the host, to indicate that the RTS line state should be high. + */ + #define CDC_CONTROL_LINE_OUT_RTS (1 << 1) + + /** Mask for the DCD handshake line for use with the \ref CDC_NOTIF_SerialState class-specific notification + * from the device to the host, to indicate that the DCD line state is currently high. + */ + #define CDC_CONTROL_LINE_IN_DCD (1 << 0) + + /** Mask for the DSR handshake line for use with the \ref CDC_NOTIF_SerialState class-specific notification + * from the device to the host, to indicate that the DSR line state is currently high. + */ + #define CDC_CONTROL_LINE_IN_DSR (1 << 1) + + /** Mask for the BREAK handshake line for use with the \ref CDC_NOTIF_SerialState class-specific notification + * from the device to the host, to indicate that the BREAK line state is currently high. + */ + #define CDC_CONTROL_LINE_IN_BREAK (1 << 2) + + /** Mask for the RING handshake line for use with the \ref CDC_NOTIF_SerialState class-specific notification + * from the device to the host, to indicate that the RING line state is currently high. + */ + #define CDC_CONTROL_LINE_IN_RING (1 << 3) + + /** Mask for use with the \ref CDC_NOTIF_SerialState class-specific notification from the device to the host, + * to indicate that a framing error has occurred on the virtual serial port. + */ + #define CDC_CONTROL_LINE_IN_FRAMEERROR (1 << 4) + + /** Mask for use with the \ref CDC_NOTIF_SerialState class-specific notification from the device to the host, + * to indicate that a parity error has occurred on the virtual serial port. + */ + #define CDC_CONTROL_LINE_IN_PARITYERROR (1 << 5) + + /** Mask for use with the \ref CDC_NOTIF_SerialState class-specific notification from the device to the host, + * to indicate that a data overrun error has occurred on the virtual serial port. + */ + #define CDC_CONTROL_LINE_IN_OVERRUNERROR (1 << 6) + //@} + + /** Macro to define a CDC class-specific functional descriptor. CDC functional descriptors have a + * uniform structure but variable sized data payloads, thus cannot be represented accurately by + * a single \c typedef \c struct. A macro is used instead so that functional descriptors can be created + * easily by specifying the size of the payload. This allows \c sizeof() to work correctly. + * + * \param[in] DataSize Size in bytes of the CDC functional descriptor's data payload. + */ + #define CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(DataSize) \ + struct \ + { \ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; \ + uint8_t SubType; \ + uint8_t Data[DataSize]; \ + } + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for possible Class, Subclass and Protocol values of device and interface descriptors relating to the CDC + * device class. + */ + enum CDC_Descriptor_ClassSubclassProtocol_t + { + CDC_CSCP_CDCClass = 0x02, /**< Descriptor Class value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to the CDC class. + */ + CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificSubclass = 0x00, /**< Descriptor Subclass value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to no specific subclass of the CDC class. + */ + CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass = 0x02, /**< Descriptor Subclass value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to the Abstract Control Model CDC subclass. + */ + CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol = 0x01, /**< Descriptor Protocol value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to the AT Command protocol of the CDC class. + */ + CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificProtocol = 0x00, /**< Descriptor Protocol value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to no specific protocol of the CDC class. + */ + CDC_CSCP_VendorSpecificProtocol = 0xFF, /**< Descriptor Protocol value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to a vendor-specific protocol of the CDC class. + */ + CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass = 0x0A, /**< Descriptor Class value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to the CDC Data class. + */ + CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass = 0x00, /**< Descriptor Subclass value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to no specific subclass of the CDC data class. + */ + CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol = 0x00, /**< Descriptor Protocol value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to no specific protocol of the CDC data class. + */ + }; + + /** Enum for the CDC class specific control requests that can be issued by the USB bus host. */ + enum CDC_ClassRequests_t + { + CDC_REQ_SendEncapsulatedCommand = 0x00, /**< CDC class-specific request to send an encapsulated command to the device. */ + CDC_REQ_GetEncapsulatedResponse = 0x01, /**< CDC class-specific request to retrieve an encapsulated command response from the device. */ + CDC_REQ_SetLineEncoding = 0x20, /**< CDC class-specific request to set the current virtual serial port configuration settings. */ + CDC_REQ_GetLineEncoding = 0x21, /**< CDC class-specific request to get the current virtual serial port configuration settings. */ + CDC_REQ_SetControlLineState = 0x22, /**< CDC class-specific request to set the current virtual serial port handshake line states. */ + CDC_REQ_SendBreak = 0x23, /**< CDC class-specific request to send a break to the receiver via the carrier channel. */ + }; + + /** Enum for the CDC class specific notification requests that can be issued by a CDC device to a host. */ + enum CDC_ClassNotifications_t + { + CDC_NOTIF_SerialState = 0x20, /**< Notification type constant for a change in the virtual serial port + * handshake line states, for use with a \ref USB_Request_Header_t + * notification structure when sent to the host via the CDC notification + * endpoint. + */ + }; + + /** Enum for the CDC class specific interface descriptor subtypes. */ + enum CDC_DescriptorSubtypes_t + { + CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header = 0x00, /**< CDC class-specific Header functional descriptor. */ + CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_CallManagement = 0x01, /**< CDC class-specific Call Management functional descriptor. */ + CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ACM = 0x02, /**< CDC class-specific Abstract Control Model functional descriptor. */ + CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_DirectLine = 0x03, /**< CDC class-specific Direct Line functional descriptor. */ + CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_TelephoneRinger = 0x04, /**< CDC class-specific Telephone Ringer functional descriptor. */ + CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_TelephoneCall = 0x05, /**< CDC class-specific Telephone Call functional descriptor. */ + CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Union = 0x06, /**< CDC class-specific Union functional descriptor. */ + CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_CountrySelection = 0x07, /**< CDC class-specific Country Selection functional descriptor. */ + CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_TelephoneOpModes = 0x08, /**< CDC class-specific Telephone Operation Modes functional descriptor. */ + CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_USBTerminal = 0x09, /**< CDC class-specific USB Terminal functional descriptor. */ + CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_NetworkChannel = 0x0A, /**< CDC class-specific Network Channel functional descriptor. */ + CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ProtocolUnit = 0x0B, /**< CDC class-specific Protocol Unit functional descriptor. */ + CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ExtensionUnit = 0x0C, /**< CDC class-specific Extension Unit functional descriptor. */ + CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_MultiChannel = 0x0D, /**< CDC class-specific Multi-Channel Management functional descriptor. */ + CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_CAPI = 0x0E, /**< CDC class-specific Common ISDN API functional descriptor. */ + CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Ethernet = 0x0F, /**< CDC class-specific Ethernet functional descriptor. */ + CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ATM = 0x10, /**< CDC class-specific Asynchronous Transfer Mode functional descriptor. */ + }; + + /** Enum for the possible line encoding formats of a virtual serial port. */ + enum CDC_LineEncodingFormats_t + { + CDC_LINEENCODING_OneStopBit = 0, /**< Each frame contains one stop bit. */ + CDC_LINEENCODING_OneAndAHalfStopBits = 1, /**< Each frame contains one and a half stop bits. */ + CDC_LINEENCODING_TwoStopBits = 2, /**< Each frame contains two stop bits. */ + }; + + /** Enum for the possible line encoding parity settings of a virtual serial port. */ + enum CDC_LineEncodingParity_t + { + CDC_PARITY_None = 0, /**< No parity bit mode on each frame. */ + CDC_PARITY_Odd = 1, /**< Odd parity bit mode on each frame. */ + CDC_PARITY_Even = 2, /**< Even parity bit mode on each frame. */ + CDC_PARITY_Mark = 3, /**< Mark parity bit mode on each frame. */ + CDC_PARITY_Space = 4, /**< Space parity bit mode on each frame. */ + }; + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief CDC class-specific Functional Header Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a CDC class-specific functional header descriptor. This indicates to the host that the device + * contains one or more CDC functional data descriptors, which give the CDC interface's capabilities and configuration. + * See the CDC class specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_CDC_StdDescriptor_FunctionalHeader_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length. */ + uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between CDC class-specific descriptors, + * must be \ref CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header. + */ + uint16_t CDCSpecification; /**< Version number of the CDC specification implemented by the device, + * encoded in BCD format. + * + * \see \ref VERSION_BCD() utility macro. + */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t; + + /** \brief CDC class-specific Functional Header Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a CDC class-specific functional header descriptor. This indicates to the host that the device + * contains one or more CDC functional data descriptors, which give the CDC interface's capabilities and configuration. + * See the CDC class specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific + * element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bFunctionLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + uint8_t bDescriptorSubType; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between CDC class-specific descriptors, + * must be \ref CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header. + */ + uint16_t bcdCDC; /**< Version number of the CDC specification implemented by the device, encoded in BCD format. + * + * \see \ref VERSION_BCD() utility macro. + */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_CDC_StdDescriptor_FunctionalHeader_t; + + /** \brief CDC class-specific Functional ACM Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a CDC class-specific functional ACM descriptor. This indicates to the host that the CDC interface + * supports the CDC ACM subclass of the CDC specification. See the CDC class specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_CDC_StdDescriptor_FunctionalACM_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length. */ + uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between CDC class-specific descriptors, + * must be \ref CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ACM. + */ + uint8_t Capabilities; /**< Capabilities of the ACM interface, given as a bit mask. For most devices, + * this should be set to a fixed value of \c 0x06 - for other capabilities, refer + * to the CDC ACM specification. + */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t; + + /** \brief CDC class-specific Functional ACM Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a CDC class-specific functional ACM descriptor. This indicates to the host that the CDC interface + * supports the CDC ACM subclass of the CDC specification. See the CDC class specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific + * element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bFunctionLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + uint8_t bDescriptorSubType; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between CDC class-specific descriptors, + * must be \ref CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ACM. + */ + uint8_t bmCapabilities; /**< Capabilities of the ACM interface, given as a bit mask. For most devices, + * this should be set to a fixed value of 0x06 - for other capabilities, refer + * to the CDC ACM specification. + */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_CDC_StdDescriptor_FunctionalACM_t; + + /** \brief CDC class-specific Functional Union Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a CDC class-specific functional Union descriptor. This indicates to the host that specific + * CDC control and data interfaces are related. See the CDC class specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_CDC_StdDescriptor_FunctionalUnion_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length. */ + uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between CDC class-specific descriptors, + * must be \ref CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Union. + */ + uint8_t MasterInterfaceNumber; /**< Interface number of the CDC Control interface. */ + uint8_t SlaveInterfaceNumber; /**< Interface number of the CDC Data interface. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t; + + /** \brief CDC class-specific Functional Union Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a CDC class-specific functional Union descriptor. This indicates to the host that specific + * CDC control and data interfaces are related. See the CDC class specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific + * element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bFunctionLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + uint8_t bDescriptorSubType; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between CDC class-specific descriptors, + * must be \ref CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Union. + */ + uint8_t bMasterInterface; /**< Interface number of the CDC Control interface. */ + uint8_t bSlaveInterface0; /**< Interface number of the CDC Data interface. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_CDC_StdDescriptor_FunctionalUnion_t; + + /** \brief CDC Virtual Serial Port Line Encoding Settings Structure. + * + * Type define for a CDC Line Encoding structure, used to hold the various encoding parameters for a virtual + * serial port. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t BaudRateBPS; /**< Baud rate of the virtual serial port, in bits per second. */ + uint8_t CharFormat; /**< Character format of the virtual serial port, a value from the + * \ref CDC_LineEncodingFormats_t enum. + */ + uint8_t ParityType; /**< Parity setting of the virtual serial port, a value from the + * \ref CDC_LineEncodingParity_t enum. + */ + uint8_t DataBits; /**< Bits of data per character of the virtual serial port. */ + } ATTR_PACKED CDC_LineEncoding_t; + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDClassCommon.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDClassCommon.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6e700a9b1e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDClassCommon.h @@ -0,0 +1,681 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Common definitions and declarations for the library USB HID Class driver. + * + * Common definitions and declarations for the library USB HID Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassHID + * \defgroup Group_USBClassHIDCommon Common Class Definitions + * + * \section Sec_USBClassHIDCommon_ModDescription Module Description + * Constants, Types and Enum definitions that are common to both Device and Host modes for the USB + * HID Class. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _HID_CLASS_COMMON_H_ +#define _HID_CLASS_COMMON_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Core/StdDescriptors.h" + #include "HIDParser.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_HID_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** \name Keyboard Standard Report Modifier Masks */ + //@{ + /** Constant for a keyboard report modifier byte, indicating that the keyboard's left control key is currently pressed. */ + #define HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFIER_LEFTCTRL (1 << 0) + + /** Constant for a keyboard report modifier byte, indicating that the keyboard's left shift key is currently pressed. */ + #define HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFIER_LEFTSHIFT (1 << 1) + + /** Constant for a keyboard report modifier byte, indicating that the keyboard's left alt key is currently pressed. */ + #define HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFIER_LEFTALT (1 << 2) + + /** Constant for a keyboard report modifier byte, indicating that the keyboard's left GUI key is currently pressed. */ + #define HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFIER_LEFTGUI (1 << 3) + + /** Constant for a keyboard report modifier byte, indicating that the keyboard's right control key is currently pressed. */ + #define HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFIER_RIGHTCTRL (1 << 4) + + /** Constant for a keyboard report modifier byte, indicating that the keyboard's right shift key is currently pressed. */ + #define HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFIER_RIGHTSHIFT (1 << 5) + + /** Constant for a keyboard report modifier byte, indicating that the keyboard's right alt key is currently pressed. */ + #define HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFIER_RIGHTALT (1 << 6) + + /** Constant for a keyboard report modifier byte, indicating that the keyboard's right GUI key is currently pressed. */ + #define HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFIER_RIGHTGUI (1 << 7) + //@} + + /** \name Keyboard Standard Report LED Masks */ + //@{ + /** Constant for a keyboard output report LED byte, indicating that the host's NUM LOCK mode is currently set. */ + #define HID_KEYBOARD_LED_NUMLOCK (1 << 0) + + /** Constant for a keyboard output report LED byte, indicating that the host's CAPS LOCK mode is currently set. */ + #define HID_KEYBOARD_LED_CAPSLOCK (1 << 1) + + /** Constant for a keyboard output report LED byte, indicating that the host's SCROLL LOCK mode is currently set. */ + #define HID_KEYBOARD_LED_SCROLLLOCK (1 << 2) + + /** Constant for a keyboard output report LED byte, indicating that the host's COMPOSE mode is currently set. */ + #define HID_KEYBOARD_LED_COMPOSE (1 << 3) + + /** Constant for a keyboard output report LED byte, indicating that the host's KANA mode is currently set. */ + #define HID_KEYBOARD_LED_KANA (1 << 4) + //@} + + /** \name Keyboard Standard Report Key Scan-codes */ + //@{ + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_ERROR_ROLLOVER 0x01 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_POST_FAIL 0x02 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_ERROR_UNDEFINED 0x03 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_A 0x04 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_B 0x05 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_C 0x06 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_D 0x07 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_E 0x08 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F 0x09 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_G 0x0A + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_H 0x0B + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_I 0x0C + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_J 0x0D + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_K 0x0E + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_L 0x0F + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_M 0x10 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_N 0x11 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_O 0x12 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_P 0x13 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_Q 0x14 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_R 0x15 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_S 0x16 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_T 0x17 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_U 0x18 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_V 0x19 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_W 0x1A + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_X 0x1B + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_Y 0x1C + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_Z 0x1D + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_1_AND_EXCLAMATION 0x1E + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_2_AND_AT 0x1F + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_3_AND_HASHMARK 0x20 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_4_AND_DOLLAR 0x21 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_5_AND_PERCENTAGE 0x22 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_6_AND_CARET 0x23 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_7_AND_AMPERSAND 0x24 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_8_AND_ASTERISK 0x25 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_9_AND_OPENING_PARENTHESIS 0x26 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_0_AND_CLOSING_PARENTHESIS 0x27 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_ENTER 0x28 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_ESCAPE 0x29 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_BACKSPACE 0x2A + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_TAB 0x2B + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_SPACE 0x2C + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MINUS_AND_UNDERSCORE 0x2D + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_EQUAL_AND_PLUS 0x2E + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_OPENING_BRACKET_AND_OPENING_BRACE 0x2F + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_CLOSING_BRACKET_AND_CLOSING_BRACE 0x30 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_BACKSLASH_AND_PIPE 0x31 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_NON_US_HASHMARK_AND_TILDE 0x32 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_SEMICOLON_AND_COLON 0x33 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_APOSTROPHE_AND_QUOTE 0x34 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_GRAVE_ACCENT_AND_TILDE 0x35 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_COMMA_AND_LESS_THAN_SIGN 0x36 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_DOT_AND_GREATER_THAN_SIGN 0x37 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_SLASH_AND_QUESTION_MARK 0x38 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_CAPS_LOCK 0x39 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F1 0x3A + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F2 0x3B + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F3 0x3C + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F4 0x3D + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F5 0x3E + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F6 0x3F + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F7 0x40 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F8 0x41 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F9 0x42 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F10 0x43 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F11 0x44 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F12 0x45 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_PRINT_SCREEN 0x46 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_SCROLL_LOCK 0x47 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_PAUSE 0x48 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_INSERT 0x49 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_HOME 0x4A + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_PAGE_UP 0x4B + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_DELETE 0x4C + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_END 0x4D + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_PAGE_DOWN 0x4E + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_RIGHT_ARROW 0x4F + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_LEFT_ARROW 0x50 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_DOWN_ARROW 0x51 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_UP_ARROW 0x52 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_NUM_LOCK 0x53 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_SLASH 0x54 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_ASTERISK 0x55 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_MINUS 0x56 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_PLUS 0x57 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_ENTER 0x58 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_1_AND_END 0x59 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_2_AND_DOWN_ARROW 0x5A + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_3_AND_PAGE_DOWN 0x5B + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_4_AND_LEFT_ARROW 0x5C + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_5 0x5D + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_6_AND_RIGHT_ARROW 0x5E + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_7_AND_HOME 0x5F + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_8_AND_UP_ARROW 0x60 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_9_AND_PAGE_UP 0x61 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_0_AND_INSERT 0x62 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_DOT_AND_DELETE 0x63 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_NON_US_BACKSLASH_AND_PIPE 0x64 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_APPLICATION 0x65 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_POWER 0x66 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_EQUAL_SIGN 0x67 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F13 0x68 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F14 0x69 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F15 0x6A + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F16 0x6B + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F17 0x6C + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F18 0x6D + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F19 0x6E + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F20 0x6F + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F21 0x70 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F22 0x71 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F23 0x72 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_F24 0x73 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_EXECUTE 0x74 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_HELP 0x75 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MENU 0x76 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_SELECT 0x77 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_STOP 0x78 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_AGAIN 0x79 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_UNDO 0x7A + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_CUT 0x7B + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_COPY 0x7C + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_PASTE 0x7D + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_FIND 0x7E + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MUTE 0x7F + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_VOLUME_UP 0x80 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_VOLUME_DOWN 0x81 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_LOCKING_CAPS_LOCK 0x82 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_LOCKING_NUM_LOCK 0x83 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_LOCKING_SCROLL_LOCK 0x84 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_COMMA 0x85 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_EQUAL_SIGN_AS400 0x86 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_INTERNATIONAL1 0x87 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_INTERNATIONAL2 0x88 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_INTERNATIONAL3 0x89 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_INTERNATIONAL4 0x8A + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_INTERNATIONAL5 0x8B + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_INTERNATIONAL6 0x8C + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_INTERNATIONAL7 0x8D + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_INTERNATIONAL8 0x8E + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_INTERNATIONAL9 0x8F + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_LANG1 0x90 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_LANG2 0x91 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_LANG3 0x92 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_LANG4 0x93 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_LANG5 0x94 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_LANG6 0x95 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_LANG7 0x96 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_LANG8 0x97 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_LANG9 0x98 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_ALTERNATE_ERASE 0x99 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_SYSREQ 0x9A + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_CANCEL 0x9B + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_CLEAR 0x9C + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_PRIOR 0x9D + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_RETURN 0x9E + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_SEPARATOR 0x9F + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_OUT 0xA0 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_OPER 0xA1 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_CLEAR_AND_AGAIN 0xA2 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_CRSEL_AND_PROPS 0xA3 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_EXSEL 0xA4 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_00 0xB0 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_000 0xB1 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_THOUSANDS_SEPARATOR 0xB2 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_DECIMAL_SEPARATOR 0xB3 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_CURRENCY_UNIT 0xB4 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_CURRENCY_SUB_UNIT 0xB5 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_OPENING_PARENTHESIS 0xB6 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_CLOSING_PARENTHESIS 0xB7 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_OPENING_BRACE 0xB8 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_CLOSING_BRACE 0xB9 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_TAB 0xBA + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_BACKSPACE 0xBB + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_A 0xBC + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_B 0xBD + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_C 0xBE + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_D 0xBF + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_E 0xC0 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_F 0xC1 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_XOR 0xC2 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_CARET 0xC3 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_PERCENTAGE 0xC4 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_LESS_THAN_SIGN 0xC5 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_GREATER_THAN_SIGN 0xC6 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_AMP 0xC7 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_AMP_AMP 0xC8 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_PIPE 0xC9 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_PIPE_PIPE 0xCA + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_COLON 0xCB + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_HASHMARK 0xCC + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_SPACE 0xCD + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_AT 0xCE + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_EXCLAMATION_SIGN 0xCF + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_MEMORY_STORE 0xD0 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_MEMORY_RECALL 0xD1 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_MEMORY_CLEAR 0xD2 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_MEMORY_ADD 0xD3 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_MEMORY_SUBTRACT 0xD4 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_MEMORY_MULTIPLY 0xD5 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_MEMORY_DIVIDE 0xD6 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_PLUS_AND_MINUS 0xD7 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_CLEAR 0xD8 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_CLEAR_ENTRY 0xD9 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_BINARY 0xDA + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_OCTAL 0xDB + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_DECIMAL 0xDC + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_KEYPAD_HEXADECIMAL 0xDD + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_LEFT_CONTROL 0xE0 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_LEFT_SHIFT 0xE1 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_LEFT_ALT 0xE2 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_LEFT_GUI 0xE3 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_RIGHT_CONTROL 0xE4 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_RIGHT_SHIFT 0xE5 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_RIGHT_ALT 0xE6 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_RIGHT_GUI 0xE7 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MEDIA_PLAY 0xE8 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MEDIA_STOP 0xE9 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MEDIA_PREVIOUS_TRACK 0xEA + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MEDIA_NEXT_TRACK 0xEB + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MEDIA_EJECT 0xEC + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MEDIA_VOLUME_UP 0xED + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MEDIA_VOLUME_DOWN 0xEE + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MEDIA_MUTE 0xEF + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MEDIA_WWW 0xF0 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MEDIA_BACKWARD 0xF1 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MEDIA_FORWARD 0xF2 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MEDIA_CANCEL 0xF3 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MEDIA_SEARCH 0xF4 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MEDIA_SLEEP 0xF8 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MEDIA_LOCK 0xF9 + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MEDIA_RELOAD 0xFA + #define HID_KEYBOARD_SC_MEDIA_CALCULATOR 0xFB + //@} + + /** \name Common HID Device Report Descriptors */ + //@{ + /** \hideinitializer + * A list of HID report item array elements that describe a typical HID USB Joystick. The resulting report + * descriptor is structured according to the following layout: + * + * \code + * struct + * { + * intA_t X; // Signed X axis value + * intA_t Y; // Signed Y axis value + * intA_t Z; // Signed Z axis value + * uintB_t Buttons; // Pressed buttons bitmask + * } Joystick_Report; + * \endcode + * + * Where \c uintA_t is a type large enough to hold the ranges of the signed \c MinAxisVal and \c MaxAxisVal values, + * and \c intB_t is a type large enough to hold one bit per button. + * + * \param[in] MinAxisVal Minimum logical axis value (16-bit). + * \param[in] MaxAxisVal Maximum logical axis value (16-bit). + * \param[in] MinPhysicalVal Minimum physical axis value, for movement resolution calculations (16-bit). + * \param[in] MaxPhysicalVal Maximum physical axis value, for movement resolution calculations (16-bit). + * \param[in] Buttons Total number of buttons in the device (8-bit). + */ + #define HID_DESCRIPTOR_JOYSTICK(MinAxisVal, MaxAxisVal, MinPhysicalVal, MaxPhysicalVal, Buttons) \ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x04), \ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x00), \ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x30), \ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x31), \ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x32), \ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(16, MinAxisVal), \ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(16, MaxAxisVal), \ + HID_RI_PHYSICAL_MINIMUM(16, MinPhysicalVal), \ + HID_RI_PHYSICAL_MAXIMUM(16, MaxPhysicalVal), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 3), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, (((MinAxisVal >= -128) && (MaxAxisVal <= 127)) ? 8 : 16)), \ + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE), \ + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0), \ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x09), \ + HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(8, Buttons), \ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), \ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, Buttons), \ + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, (Buttons % 8) ? (8 - (Buttons % 8)) : 0), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_CONSTANT), \ + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0) + + /** \hideinitializer + * A list of HID report item array elements that describe a typical HID USB keyboard. The resulting report descriptor + * is compatible with \ref USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t when \c MaxKeys is equal to 6. For other values, the report will + * be structured according to the following layout: + * + * \code + * struct + * { + * uint8_t Modifier; // Keyboard modifier byte indicating pressed modifier keys (\c HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFER_* masks) + * uint8_t Reserved; // Reserved for OEM use, always set to 0. + * uint8_t KeyCode[MaxKeys]; // Length determined by the number of keys that can be reported + * } Keyboard_Report; + * \endcode + * + * \param[in] MaxKeys Number of simultaneous keys that can be reported at the one time (8-bit). + */ + #define HID_DESCRIPTOR_KEYBOARD(MaxKeys) \ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x06), \ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x07), \ + HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(8, 0xE0), \ + HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(8, 0xE7), \ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), \ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x08), \ + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x08), \ + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_CONSTANT), \ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x08), \ + HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(8, 0x05), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x05), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_OUTPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE | HID_IOF_NON_VOLATILE), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x03), \ + HID_RI_OUTPUT(8, HID_IOF_CONSTANT), \ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), \ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(16, 0xFF), \ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x07), \ + HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), \ + HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(8, 0xFF), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, MaxKeys), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x08), \ + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_ARRAY | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE), \ + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0) + + /** \hideinitializer + * A list of HID report item array elements that describe a typical HID USB mouse. The resulting report descriptor + * is compatible with \ref USB_MouseReport_Data_t if the \c MinAxisVal and \c MaxAxisVal values fit within a \c int8_t range + * and the number of Buttons is less than 8. For other values, the report is structured according to the following layout: + * + * \code + * struct + * { + * uintA_t Buttons; // Pressed buttons bitmask + * intB_t X; // X axis value + * intB_t Y; // Y axis value + * } Mouse_Report; + * \endcode + * + * Where \c intA_t is a type large enough to hold one bit per button, and \c intB_t is a type large enough to hold the + * ranges of the signed \c MinAxisVal and \c MaxAxisVal values. + * + * \param[in] MinAxisVal Minimum X/Y logical axis value (16-bit). + * \param[in] MaxAxisVal Maximum X/Y logical axis value (16-bit). + * \param[in] MinPhysicalVal Minimum X/Y physical axis value, for movement resolution calculations (16-bit). + * \param[in] MaxPhysicalVal Maximum X/Y physical axis value, for movement resolution calculations (16-bit). + * \param[in] Buttons Total number of buttons in the device (8-bit). + * \param[in] AbsoluteCoords Boolean \c true to use absolute X/Y coordinates (e.g. touchscreen). + */ + #define HID_DESCRIPTOR_MOUSE(MinAxisVal, MaxAxisVal, MinPhysicalVal, MaxPhysicalVal, Buttons, AbsoluteCoords) \ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x02), \ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x00), \ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x09), \ + HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(8, Buttons), \ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), \ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, Buttons), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, (Buttons % 8) ? (8 - (Buttons % 8)) : 0), \ + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_CONSTANT), \ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x30), \ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x31), \ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(16, MinAxisVal), \ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(16, MaxAxisVal), \ + HID_RI_PHYSICAL_MINIMUM(16, MinPhysicalVal), \ + HID_RI_PHYSICAL_MAXIMUM(16, MaxPhysicalVal), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x02), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, (((MinAxisVal >= -128) && (MaxAxisVal <= 127)) ? 8 : 16)), \ + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | (AbsoluteCoords ? HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE : HID_IOF_RELATIVE)), \ + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0), \ + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0) + + /** \hideinitializer + * A list of HID report item array elements that describe a typical Vendor Defined byte array HID report descriptor, + * used for transporting arbitrary data between the USB host and device via HID reports. The resulting report should be + * a \c uint8_t byte array of the specified length in both Device to Host (IN) and Host to Device (OUT) directions. + * + * \param[in] VendorPageNum Vendor Defined HID Usage Page index, ranging from 0x00 to 0xFF. + * \param[in] CollectionUsage Vendor Usage for the encompassing report IN and OUT collection, ranging from 0x00 to 0xFF. + * \param[in] DataINUsage Vendor Usage for the IN report data, ranging from 0x00 to 0xFF. + * \param[in] DataOUTUsage Vendor Usage for the OUT report data, ranging from 0x00 to 0xFF. + * \param[in] NumBytes Length of the data IN and OUT reports. + */ + #define HID_DESCRIPTOR_VENDOR(VendorPageNum, CollectionUsage, DataINUsage, DataOUTUsage, NumBytes) \ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(16, (0xFF00 | VendorPageNum)), \ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, CollectionUsage), \ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x01), \ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, DataINUsage), \ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), \ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 0xFF), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x08), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, NumBytes), \ + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE), \ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, DataOUTUsage), \ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0x00), \ + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 0xFF), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x08), \ + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, NumBytes), \ + HID_RI_OUTPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE | HID_IOF_NON_VOLATILE), \ + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0) + //@} + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Enum for possible Class, Subclass and Protocol values of device and interface descriptors relating to the HID + * device class. + */ + enum HID_Descriptor_ClassSubclassProtocol_t + { + HID_CSCP_HIDClass = 0x03, /**< Descriptor Class value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to the HID class. + */ + HID_CSCP_NonBootSubclass = 0x00, /**< Descriptor Subclass value indicating that the device or interface + * does not implement a HID boot protocol. + */ + HID_CSCP_BootSubclass = 0x01, /**< Descriptor Subclass value indicating that the device or interface + * implements a HID boot protocol. + */ + HID_CSCP_NonBootProtocol = 0x00, /**< Descriptor Protocol value indicating that the device or interface + * does not belong to a HID boot protocol. + */ + HID_CSCP_KeyboardBootProtocol = 0x01, /**< Descriptor Protocol value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to the Keyboard HID boot protocol. + */ + HID_CSCP_MouseBootProtocol = 0x02, /**< Descriptor Protocol value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to the Mouse HID boot protocol. + */ + }; + + /** Enum for the HID class specific control requests that can be issued by the USB bus host. */ + enum HID_ClassRequests_t + { + HID_REQ_GetReport = 0x01, /**< HID class-specific Request to get the current HID report from the device. */ + HID_REQ_GetIdle = 0x02, /**< HID class-specific Request to get the current device idle count. */ + HID_REQ_GetProtocol = 0x03, /**< HID class-specific Request to get the current HID report protocol mode. */ + HID_REQ_SetReport = 0x09, /**< HID class-specific Request to set the current HID report to the device. */ + HID_REQ_SetIdle = 0x0A, /**< HID class-specific Request to set the device's idle count. */ + HID_REQ_SetProtocol = 0x0B, /**< HID class-specific Request to set the current HID report protocol mode. */ + }; + + /** Enum for the HID class specific descriptor types. */ + enum HID_DescriptorTypes_t + { + HID_DTYPE_HID = 0x21, /**< Descriptor header type value, to indicate a HID class HID descriptor. */ + HID_DTYPE_Report = 0x22, /**< Descriptor header type value, to indicate a HID class HID report descriptor. */ + }; + + /** Enum for the different types of HID reports. */ + enum HID_ReportItemTypes_t + { + HID_REPORT_ITEM_In = 0, /**< Indicates that the item is an IN report type. */ + HID_REPORT_ITEM_Out = 1, /**< Indicates that the item is an OUT report type. */ + HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature = 2, /**< Indicates that the item is a FEATURE report type. */ + }; + + /** \brief HID class-specific HID Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for the HID class-specific HID descriptor, to describe the HID device's specifications. Refer to the HID + * specification for details on the structure elements. + * + * \see \ref USB_HID_StdDescriptor_HID_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length. */ + + uint16_t HIDSpec; /**< BCD encoded version that the HID descriptor and device complies to. + * + * \see \ref VERSION_BCD() utility macro. + */ + uint8_t CountryCode; /**< Country code of the localized device, or zero if universal. */ + + uint8_t TotalReportDescriptors; /**< Total number of HID report descriptors for the interface. */ + + uint8_t HIDReportType; /**< Type of HID report, set to \ref HID_DTYPE_Report. */ + uint16_t HIDReportLength; /**< Length of the associated HID report descriptor, in bytes. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t; + + /** \brief HID class-specific HID Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for the HID class-specific HID descriptor, to describe the HID device's specifications. Refer to the HID + * specification for details on the structure elements. + * + * \see \ref USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific + * element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + + uint16_t bcdHID; /**< BCD encoded version that the HID descriptor and device complies to. + * + * \see \ref VERSION_BCD() utility macro. + */ + uint8_t bCountryCode; /**< Country code of the localized device, or zero if universal. */ + + uint8_t bNumDescriptors; /**< Total number of HID report descriptors for the interface. */ + + uint8_t bDescriptorType2; /**< Type of HID report, set to \ref HID_DTYPE_Report. */ + uint16_t wDescriptorLength; /**< Length of the associated HID report descriptor, in bytes. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_HID_StdDescriptor_HID_t; + + /** \brief Standard HID Boot Protocol Mouse Report. + * + * Type define for a standard Boot Protocol Mouse report + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Button; /**< Button mask for currently pressed buttons in the mouse. */ + int8_t X; /**< Current delta X movement of the mouse. */ + int8_t Y; /**< Current delta Y movement on the mouse. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_MouseReport_Data_t; + + /** \brief Standard HID Boot Protocol Keyboard Report. + * + * Type define for a standard Boot Protocol Keyboard report + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Modifier; /**< Keyboard modifier byte, indicating pressed modifier keys (a combination of + * \c HID_KEYBOARD_MODIFER_* masks). + */ + uint8_t Reserved; /**< Reserved for OEM use, always set to 0. */ + uint8_t KeyCode[6]; /**< Key codes of the currently pressed keys. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t; + + /** Type define for the data type used to store HID report descriptor elements. */ + typedef uint8_t USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t; + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDParser.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDParser.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..62f10c4e22 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDParser.c @@ -0,0 +1,389 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_HID_DRIVER +#include "HIDParser.h" + +uint8_t USB_ProcessHIDReport(const uint8_t* ReportData, + uint16_t ReportSize, + HID_ReportInfo_t* const ParserData) +{ + HID_StateTable_t StateTable[HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH]; + HID_StateTable_t* CurrStateTable = &StateTable[0]; + HID_CollectionPath_t* CurrCollectionPath = NULL; + HID_ReportSizeInfo_t* CurrReportIDInfo = &ParserData->ReportIDSizes[0]; + uint16_t UsageList[HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH]; + uint8_t UsageListSize = 0; + HID_MinMax_t UsageMinMax = {0, 0}; + + memset(ParserData, 0x00, sizeof(HID_ReportInfo_t)); + memset(CurrStateTable, 0x00, sizeof(HID_StateTable_t)); + memset(CurrReportIDInfo, 0x00, sizeof(HID_ReportSizeInfo_t)); + + ParserData->TotalDeviceReports = 1; + + while (ReportSize) + { + uint8_t HIDReportItem = *ReportData; + uint32_t ReportItemData; + + ReportData++; + ReportSize--; + + switch (HIDReportItem & HID_RI_DATA_SIZE_MASK) + { + case HID_RI_DATA_BITS_32: + ReportItemData = (((uint32_t)ReportData[3] << 24) | ((uint32_t)ReportData[2] << 16) | + ((uint16_t)ReportData[1] << 8) | ReportData[0]); + ReportSize -= 4; + ReportData += 4; + break; + + case HID_RI_DATA_BITS_16: + ReportItemData = (((uint16_t)ReportData[1] << 8) | (ReportData[0])); + ReportSize -= 2; + ReportData += 2; + break; + + case HID_RI_DATA_BITS_8: + ReportItemData = ReportData[0]; + ReportSize -= 1; + ReportData += 1; + break; + + default: + ReportItemData = 0; + break; + } + + switch (HIDReportItem & (HID_RI_TYPE_MASK | HID_RI_TAG_MASK)) + { + case HID_RI_PUSH(0): + if (CurrStateTable == &StateTable[HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH - 1]) + return HID_PARSE_HIDStackOverflow; + + memcpy((CurrStateTable + 1), + CurrStateTable, + sizeof(HID_ReportItem_t)); + + CurrStateTable++; + break; + + case HID_RI_POP(0): + if (CurrStateTable == &StateTable[0]) + return HID_PARSE_HIDStackUnderflow; + + CurrStateTable--; + break; + + case HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(0): + if ((HIDReportItem & HID_RI_DATA_SIZE_MASK) == HID_RI_DATA_BITS_32) + CurrStateTable->Attributes.Usage.Page = (ReportItemData >> 16); + + CurrStateTable->Attributes.Usage.Page = ReportItemData; + break; + + case HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(0): + CurrStateTable->Attributes.Logical.Minimum = ReportItemData; + break; + + case HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(0): + CurrStateTable->Attributes.Logical.Maximum = ReportItemData; + break; + + case HID_RI_PHYSICAL_MINIMUM(0): + CurrStateTable->Attributes.Physical.Minimum = ReportItemData; + break; + + case HID_RI_PHYSICAL_MAXIMUM(0): + CurrStateTable->Attributes.Physical.Maximum = ReportItemData; + break; + + case HID_RI_UNIT_EXPONENT(0): + CurrStateTable->Attributes.Unit.Exponent = ReportItemData; + break; + + case HID_RI_UNIT(0): + CurrStateTable->Attributes.Unit.Type = ReportItemData; + break; + + case HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(0): + CurrStateTable->Attributes.BitSize = ReportItemData; + break; + + case HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(0): + CurrStateTable->ReportCount = ReportItemData; + break; + + case HID_RI_REPORT_ID(0): + CurrStateTable->ReportID = ReportItemData; + + if (ParserData->UsingReportIDs) + { + CurrReportIDInfo = NULL; + + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < ParserData->TotalDeviceReports; i++) + { + if (ParserData->ReportIDSizes[i].ReportID == CurrStateTable->ReportID) + { + CurrReportIDInfo = &ParserData->ReportIDSizes[i]; + break; + } + } + + if (CurrReportIDInfo == NULL) + { + if (ParserData->TotalDeviceReports == HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS) + return HID_PARSE_InsufficientReportIDItems; + + CurrReportIDInfo = &ParserData->ReportIDSizes[ParserData->TotalDeviceReports++]; + memset(CurrReportIDInfo, 0x00, sizeof(HID_ReportSizeInfo_t)); + } + } + + ParserData->UsingReportIDs = true; + + CurrReportIDInfo->ReportID = CurrStateTable->ReportID; + break; + + case HID_RI_USAGE(0): + if (UsageListSize == HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH) + return HID_PARSE_UsageListOverflow; + + UsageList[UsageListSize++] = ReportItemData; + break; + + case HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(0): + UsageMinMax.Minimum = ReportItemData; + break; + + case HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(0): + UsageMinMax.Maximum = ReportItemData; + break; + + case HID_RI_COLLECTION(0): + if (CurrCollectionPath == NULL) + { + CurrCollectionPath = &ParserData->CollectionPaths[0]; + } + else + { + HID_CollectionPath_t* ParentCollectionPath = CurrCollectionPath; + + CurrCollectionPath = &ParserData->CollectionPaths[1]; + + while (CurrCollectionPath->Parent != NULL) + { + if (CurrCollectionPath == &ParserData->CollectionPaths[HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS - 1]) + return HID_PARSE_InsufficientCollectionPaths; + + CurrCollectionPath++; + } + + CurrCollectionPath->Parent = ParentCollectionPath; + } + + CurrCollectionPath->Type = ReportItemData; + CurrCollectionPath->Usage.Page = CurrStateTable->Attributes.Usage.Page; + + if (UsageListSize) + { + CurrCollectionPath->Usage.Usage = UsageList[0]; + + for (uint8_t i = 1; i < UsageListSize; i++) + UsageList[i - 1] = UsageList[i]; + + UsageListSize--; + } + else if (UsageMinMax.Minimum <= UsageMinMax.Maximum) + { + CurrCollectionPath->Usage.Usage = UsageMinMax.Minimum++; + } + + break; + + case HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0): + if (CurrCollectionPath == NULL) + return HID_PARSE_UnexpectedEndCollection; + + CurrCollectionPath = CurrCollectionPath->Parent; + break; + + case HID_RI_INPUT(0): + case HID_RI_OUTPUT(0): + case HID_RI_FEATURE(0): + for (uint8_t ReportItemNum = 0; ReportItemNum < CurrStateTable->ReportCount; ReportItemNum++) + { + HID_ReportItem_t NewReportItem; + + memcpy(&NewReportItem.Attributes, + &CurrStateTable->Attributes, + sizeof(HID_ReportItem_Attributes_t)); + + NewReportItem.ItemFlags = ReportItemData; + NewReportItem.CollectionPath = CurrCollectionPath; + NewReportItem.ReportID = CurrStateTable->ReportID; + + if (UsageListSize) + { + NewReportItem.Attributes.Usage.Usage = UsageList[0]; + + for (uint8_t i = 1; i < UsageListSize; i++) + UsageList[i - 1] = UsageList[i]; + + UsageListSize--; + } + else if (UsageMinMax.Minimum <= UsageMinMax.Maximum) + { + NewReportItem.Attributes.Usage.Usage = UsageMinMax.Minimum++; + } + + uint8_t ItemTypeTag = (HIDReportItem & (HID_RI_TYPE_MASK | HID_RI_TAG_MASK)); + + if (ItemTypeTag == HID_RI_INPUT(0)) + NewReportItem.ItemType = HID_REPORT_ITEM_In; + else if (ItemTypeTag == HID_RI_OUTPUT(0)) + NewReportItem.ItemType = HID_REPORT_ITEM_Out; + else + NewReportItem.ItemType = HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature; + + NewReportItem.BitOffset = CurrReportIDInfo->ReportSizeBits[NewReportItem.ItemType]; + + CurrReportIDInfo->ReportSizeBits[NewReportItem.ItemType] += CurrStateTable->Attributes.BitSize; + + ParserData->LargestReportSizeBits = MAX(ParserData->LargestReportSizeBits, CurrReportIDInfo->ReportSizeBits[NewReportItem.ItemType]); + + if (ParserData->TotalReportItems == HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS) + return HID_PARSE_InsufficientReportItems; + + memcpy(&ParserData->ReportItems[ParserData->TotalReportItems], + &NewReportItem, sizeof(HID_ReportItem_t)); + + if (!(ReportItemData & HID_IOF_CONSTANT) && CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem(&NewReportItem)) + ParserData->TotalReportItems++; + } + + break; + + default: + break; + } + + if ((HIDReportItem & HID_RI_TYPE_MASK) == HID_RI_TYPE_MAIN) + { + UsageMinMax.Minimum = 0; + UsageMinMax.Maximum = 0; + UsageListSize = 0; + } + } + + if (!(ParserData->TotalReportItems)) + return HID_PARSE_NoUnfilteredReportItems; + + return HID_PARSE_Successful; +} + +bool USB_GetHIDReportItemInfo(const uint8_t* ReportData, + HID_ReportItem_t* const ReportItem) +{ + if (ReportItem == NULL) + return false; + + uint16_t DataBitsRem = ReportItem->Attributes.BitSize; + uint16_t CurrentBit = ReportItem->BitOffset; + uint32_t BitMask = (1 << 0); + + if (ReportItem->ReportID) + { + if (ReportItem->ReportID != ReportData[0]) + return false; + + ReportData++; + } + + ReportItem->PreviousValue = ReportItem->Value; + ReportItem->Value = 0; + + while (DataBitsRem--) + { + if (ReportData[CurrentBit / 8] & (1 << (CurrentBit % 8))) + ReportItem->Value |= BitMask; + + CurrentBit++; + BitMask <<= 1; + } + + return true; +} + +void USB_SetHIDReportItemInfo(uint8_t* ReportData, + HID_ReportItem_t* const ReportItem) +{ + if (ReportItem == NULL) + return; + + uint16_t DataBitsRem = ReportItem->Attributes.BitSize; + uint16_t CurrentBit = ReportItem->BitOffset; + uint32_t BitMask = (1 << 0); + + if (ReportItem->ReportID) + { + ReportData[0] = ReportItem->ReportID; + ReportData++; + } + + ReportItem->PreviousValue = ReportItem->Value; + + while (DataBitsRem--) + { + if (ReportItem->Value & BitMask) + ReportData[CurrentBit / 8] |= (1 << (CurrentBit % 8)); + + CurrentBit++; + BitMask <<= 1; + } +} + +uint16_t USB_GetHIDReportSize(HID_ReportInfo_t* const ParserData, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType) +{ + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS; i++) + { + uint16_t ReportSizeBits = ParserData->ReportIDSizes[i].ReportSizeBits[ReportType]; + + if (ParserData->ReportIDSizes[i].ReportID == ReportID) + return (ReportSizeBits / 8) + ((ReportSizeBits % 8) ? 1 : 0); + } + + return 0; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDParser.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDParser.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..023316d7ea --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDParser.h @@ -0,0 +1,364 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Human Interface Device (HID) Class report descriptor parser. + * + * This file allows for the easy parsing of complex HID report descriptors, which describes the data that + * a HID device transmits to the host. It also provides an easy API for extracting and processing the data + * elements inside a HID report sent from an attached HID device. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USB + * \defgroup Group_HIDParser HID Report Parser + * \brief USB Human Interface Device (HID) Class report descriptor parser. + * + * \section Sec_HIDParser_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/HIDParser.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USB)</i> + * + * \section Sec_HIDParser_ModDescription Module Description + * Human Interface Device (HID) class report descriptor parser. This module implements a parser than is + * capable of processing a complete HID report descriptor, and outputting a flat structure containing the + * contents of the report in an a more friendly format. The parsed data may then be further processed and used + * within an application to process sent and received HID reports to and from an attached HID device. + * + * A HID report descriptor consists of a set of HID report items, which describe the function and layout + * of data exchanged between a HID device and a host, including both the physical encoding of each item + * (such as a button, key press or joystick axis) in the sent and received data packets - known as "reports" - + * as well as other information about each item such as the usages, data range, physical location and other + * characteristics. In this way a HID device can retain a high degree of flexibility in its capabilities, as it + * is not forced to comply with a given report layout or feature-set. + * + * This module also contains routines for the processing of data in an actual HID report, using the parsed report + * descriptor data as a guide for the encoding. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __HIDPARSER_H__ +#define __HIDPARSER_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + #include "HIDReportData.h" + #include "HIDClassCommon.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + #if !defined(HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Constant indicating the maximum stack depth of the state table. A larger state table + * allows for more PUSH/POP report items to be nested, but consumes more memory. By default + * this is set to 2 levels (allowing non-nested PUSH items) but this can be overridden by + * defining \c HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH to another value in the user project makefile, passing the + * define to the compiler using the -D compiler switch. + */ + #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH 2 + #endif + + #if !defined(HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Constant indicating the maximum stack depth of the usage table. A larger usage table + * allows for more USAGE items to be indicated sequentially for REPORT COUNT entries of more than + * one, but requires more stack space. By default this is set to 8 levels (allowing for a report + * item with a count of 8) but this can be overridden by defining \c HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH to another + * value in the user project makefile, passing the define to the compiler using the -D compiler + * switch. + */ + #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH 8 + #endif + + #if !defined(HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Constant indicating the maximum number of COLLECTION items (nested or unnested) that can be + * processed in the report item descriptor. A large value allows for more COLLECTION items to be + * processed, but consumes more memory. By default this is set to 10 collections, but this can be + * overridden by defining \c HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS to another value in the user project makefile, passing + * the define to the compiler using the -D compiler switch. + */ + #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS 10 + #endif + + #if !defined(HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Constant indicating the maximum number of report items (IN, OUT or FEATURE) that can be processed + * in the report item descriptor and stored in the user HID Report Info structure. A large value allows + * for more report items to be stored, but consumes more memory. By default this is set to 20 items, + * but this can be overridden by defining \c HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS to another value in the user project + * makefile, and passing the define to the compiler using the -D compiler switch. + */ + #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS 20 + #endif + + #if !defined(HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Constant indicating the maximum number of unique report IDs that can be processed in the report item + * descriptor for the report size information array in the user HID Report Info structure. A large value + * allows for more report ID report sizes to be stored, but consumes more memory. By default this is set + * to 10 items, but this can be overridden by defining \c HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS to another value in the user project + * makefile, and passing the define to the compiler using the -D compiler switch. Note that IN, OUT and FEATURE + * items sharing the same report ID consume only one size item in the array. + */ + #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS 10 + #endif + + /** Returns the value a given HID report item (once its value has been fetched via \ref USB_GetHIDReportItemInfo()) + * left-aligned to the given data type. This allows for signed data to be interpreted correctly, by shifting the data + * leftwards until the data's sign bit is in the correct position. + * + * \param[in] ReportItem HID Report Item whose retrieved value is to be aligned. + * \param[in] Type Data type to align the HID report item's value to. + * + * \return Left-aligned data of the given report item's pre-retrieved value for the given datatype. + */ + #define HID_ALIGN_DATA(ReportItem, Type) ((Type)(ReportItem->Value << ((8 * sizeof(Type)) - ReportItem->Attributes.BitSize))) + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible error codes in the return value of the \ref USB_ProcessHIDReport() function. */ + enum HID_Parse_ErrorCodes_t + { + HID_PARSE_Successful = 0, /**< Successful parse of the HID report descriptor, no error. */ + HID_PARSE_HIDStackOverflow = 1, /**< More than \ref HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH nested PUSHes in the report. */ + HID_PARSE_HIDStackUnderflow = 2, /**< A POP was found when the state table stack was empty. */ + HID_PARSE_InsufficientReportItems = 3, /**< More than \ref HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS report items in the report. */ + HID_PARSE_UnexpectedEndCollection = 4, /**< An END COLLECTION item found without matching COLLECTION item. */ + HID_PARSE_InsufficientCollectionPaths = 5, /**< More than \ref HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS collections in the report. */ + HID_PARSE_UsageListOverflow = 6, /**< More than \ref HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH usages listed in a row. */ + HID_PARSE_InsufficientReportIDItems = 7, /**< More than \ref HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS report IDs in the device. */ + HID_PARSE_NoUnfilteredReportItems = 8, /**< All report items from the device were filtered by the filtering callback routine. */ + }; + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief HID Parser Report Item Min/Max Structure. + * + * Type define for an attribute with both minimum and maximum values (e.g. Logical Min/Max). + */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t Minimum; /**< Minimum value for the attribute. */ + uint32_t Maximum; /**< Maximum value for the attribute. */ + } HID_MinMax_t; + + /** \brief HID Parser Report Item Unit Structure. + * + * Type define for the Unit attributes of a report item. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t Type; /**< Unit type (refer to HID specifications for details). */ + uint8_t Exponent; /**< Unit exponent (refer to HID specifications for details). */ + } HID_Unit_t; + + /** \brief HID Parser Report Item Usage Structure. + * + * Type define for the Usage attributes of a report item. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint16_t Page; /**< Usage page of the report item. */ + uint16_t Usage; /**< Usage of the report item. */ + } HID_Usage_t; + + /** \brief HID Parser Report Item Collection Path Structure. + * + * Type define for a COLLECTION object. Contains the collection attributes and a reference to the + * parent collection if any. + */ + typedef struct HID_CollectionPath + { + uint8_t Type; /**< Collection type (e.g. "Generic Desktop"). */ + HID_Usage_t Usage; /**< Collection usage. */ + struct HID_CollectionPath* Parent; /**< Reference to parent collection, or \c NULL if root collection. */ + } HID_CollectionPath_t; + + /** \brief HID Parser Report Item Attributes Structure. + * + * Type define for all the data attributes of a report item, except flags. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t BitSize; /**< Size in bits of the report item's data. */ + + HID_Usage_t Usage; /**< Usage of the report item. */ + HID_Unit_t Unit; /**< Unit type and exponent of the report item. */ + HID_MinMax_t Logical; /**< Logical minimum and maximum of the report item. */ + HID_MinMax_t Physical; /**< Physical minimum and maximum of the report item. */ + } HID_ReportItem_Attributes_t; + + /** \brief HID Parser Report Item Details Structure. + * + * Type define for a report item (IN, OUT or FEATURE) layout attributes and other details. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint16_t BitOffset; /**< Bit offset in the IN, OUT or FEATURE report of the item. */ + uint8_t ItemType; /**< Report item type, a value in \ref HID_ReportItemTypes_t. */ + uint16_t ItemFlags; /**< Item data flags, a mask of \c HID_IOF_* constants. */ + uint8_t ReportID; /**< Report ID this item belongs to, or 0x00 if device has only one report */ + HID_CollectionPath_t* CollectionPath; /**< Collection path of the item. */ + + HID_ReportItem_Attributes_t Attributes; /**< Report item attributes. */ + + uint32_t Value; /**< Current value of the report item - use \ref HID_ALIGN_DATA() when processing + * a retrieved value so that it is aligned to a specific type. + */ + uint32_t PreviousValue; /**< Previous value of the report item. */ + } HID_ReportItem_t; + + /** \brief HID Parser Report Size Structure. + * + * Type define for a report item size information structure, to retain the size of a device's reports by ID. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t ReportID; /**< Report ID of the report within the HID interface. */ + uint16_t ReportSizeBits[3]; /**< Total number of bits in each report type for the given Report ID, + * indexed by the \ref HID_ReportItemTypes_t enum. + */ + } HID_ReportSizeInfo_t; + + /** \brief HID Parser State Structure. + * + * Type define for a complete processed HID report, including all report item data and collections. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t TotalReportItems; /**< Total number of report items stored in the \c ReportItems array. */ + HID_ReportItem_t ReportItems[HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS]; /**< Report items array, including all IN, OUT + * and FEATURE items. + */ + HID_CollectionPath_t CollectionPaths[HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS]; /**< All collection items, referenced + * by the report items. + */ + uint8_t TotalDeviceReports; /**< Number of reports within the HID interface */ + HID_ReportSizeInfo_t ReportIDSizes[HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS]; /**< Report sizes for each report in the interface */ + uint16_t LargestReportSizeBits; /**< Largest report that the attached device will generate, in bits */ + bool UsingReportIDs; /**< Indicates if the device has at least one REPORT ID + * element in its HID report descriptor. + */ + } HID_ReportInfo_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Function to process a given HID report returned from an attached device, and store it into a given + * \ref HID_ReportInfo_t structure. + * + * \param[in] ReportData Buffer containing the device's HID report table. + * \param[in] ReportSize Size in bytes of the HID report table. + * \param[out] ParserData Pointer to a \ref HID_ReportInfo_t instance for the parser output. + * + * \return A value in the \ref HID_Parse_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t USB_ProcessHIDReport(const uint8_t* ReportData, + uint16_t ReportSize, + HID_ReportInfo_t* const ParserData) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /** Extracts the given report item's value out of the given HID report and places it into the Value + * member of the report item's \ref HID_ReportItem_t structure. + * + * When called on a report with an item that exists in that report, this copies the report item's \c Value + * to its \c PreviousValue element for easy checking to see if an item's value has changed before processing + * a report. If the given item does not exist in the report, the function does not modify the report item's + * data. + * + * \param[in] ReportData Buffer containing an IN or FEATURE report from an attached device. + * \param[in,out] ReportItem Pointer to the report item of interest in a \ref HID_ReportInfo_t ReportItem array. + * + * \returns Boolean \c true if the item to retrieve was located in the given report, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool USB_GetHIDReportItemInfo(const uint8_t* ReportData, + HID_ReportItem_t* const ReportItem) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Retrieves the given report item's value out of the \c Value member of the report item's + * \ref HID_ReportItem_t structure and places it into the correct position in the HID report + * buffer. The report buffer is assumed to have the appropriate bits cleared before calling + * this function (i.e., the buffer should be explicitly cleared before report values are added). + * + * When called, this copies the report item's \c Value element to its \c PreviousValue element for easy + * checking to see if an item's value has changed before sending a report. + * + * If the device has multiple HID reports, the first byte in the report is set to the report ID of the given item. + * + * \param[out] ReportData Buffer holding the current OUT or FEATURE report data. + * \param[in] ReportItem Pointer to the report item of interest in a \ref HID_ReportInfo_t ReportItem array. + */ + void USB_SetHIDReportItemInfo(uint8_t* ReportData, + HID_ReportItem_t* const ReportItem) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Retrieves the size of a given HID report in bytes from its Report ID. + * + * \param[in] ParserData Pointer to a \ref HID_ReportInfo_t instance containing the parser output. + * \param[in] ReportID Report ID of the report whose size is to be determined. + * \param[in] ReportType Type of the report whose size is to be determined, a value from the + * \ref HID_ReportItemTypes_t enum. + * + * \return Size of the report in bytes, or \c 0 if the report does not exist. + */ + uint16_t USB_GetHIDReportSize(HID_ReportInfo_t* const ParserData, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType) ATTR_CONST ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Callback routine for the HID Report Parser. This callback <b>must</b> be implemented by the user code when + * the parser is used, to determine what report IN, OUT and FEATURE item's information is stored into the user + * \ref HID_ReportInfo_t structure. This can be used to filter only those items the application will be using, so that + * no RAM is wasted storing the attributes for report items which will never be referenced by the application. + * + * Report item pointers passed to this callback function may be cached by the user application for later use + * when processing report items. This provides faster report processing in the user application than would + * a search of the entire parsed report item table for each received or sent report. + * + * \param[in] CurrentItem Pointer to the current report item for user checking. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the item should be stored into the \ref HID_ReportInfo_t structure, \c false if + * it should be ignored. + */ + bool CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem(HID_ReportItem_t* const CurrentItem); + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Type Defines: */ + typedef struct + { + HID_ReportItem_Attributes_t Attributes; + uint8_t ReportCount; + uint8_t ReportID; + } HID_StateTable_t; + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDReportData.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDReportData.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fe1c4df943 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDReportData.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Constants for HID report item attributes. + * + * HID report item constants for report item attributes. Refer to the HID specification for + * details on each flag's meaning when applied to an IN, OUT or FEATURE item. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_HIDParser + * \defgroup Group_HIDReportItemConst HID Report Descriptor Item Constants + * + * General HID constant definitions for HID Report Descriptor elements. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __HIDREPORTDATA_H__ +#define __HIDREPORTDATA_H__ + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define HID_RI_DATA_SIZE_MASK 0x03 + #define HID_RI_TYPE_MASK 0x0C + #define HID_RI_TAG_MASK 0xF0 + + #define HID_RI_TYPE_MAIN 0x00 + #define HID_RI_TYPE_GLOBAL 0x04 + #define HID_RI_TYPE_LOCAL 0x08 + + #define HID_RI_DATA_BITS_0 0x00 + #define HID_RI_DATA_BITS_8 0x01 + #define HID_RI_DATA_BITS_16 0x02 + #define HID_RI_DATA_BITS_32 0x03 + #define HID_RI_DATA_BITS(DataBits) CONCAT_EXPANDED(HID_RI_DATA_BITS_, DataBits) + + #define _HID_RI_ENCODE_0(Data) + #define _HID_RI_ENCODE_8(Data) , (Data & 0xFF) + #define _HID_RI_ENCODE_16(Data) _HID_RI_ENCODE_8(Data) _HID_RI_ENCODE_8(Data >> 8) + #define _HID_RI_ENCODE_32(Data) _HID_RI_ENCODE_16(Data) _HID_RI_ENCODE_16(Data >> 16) + #define _HID_RI_ENCODE(DataBits, ...) CONCAT_EXPANDED(_HID_RI_ENCODE_, DataBits(__VA_ARGS__)) + + #define _HID_RI_ENTRY(Type, Tag, DataBits, ...) (Type | Tag | HID_RI_DATA_BITS(DataBits)) _HID_RI_ENCODE(DataBits, (__VA_ARGS__)) + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** \name HID Input, Output and Feature Report Descriptor Item Flags */ + //@{ + #define HID_IOF_CONSTANT (1 << 0) + #define HID_IOF_DATA (0 << 0) + #define HID_IOF_VARIABLE (1 << 1) + #define HID_IOF_ARRAY (0 << 1) + #define HID_IOF_RELATIVE (1 << 2) + #define HID_IOF_ABSOLUTE (0 << 2) + #define HID_IOF_WRAP (1 << 3) + #define HID_IOF_NO_WRAP (0 << 3) + #define HID_IOF_NON_LINEAR (1 << 4) + #define HID_IOF_LINEAR (0 << 4) + #define HID_IOF_NO_PREFERRED_STATE (1 << 5) + #define HID_IOF_PREFERRED_STATE (0 << 5) + #define HID_IOF_NULLSTATE (1 << 6) + #define HID_IOF_NO_NULL_POSITION (0 << 6) + #define HID_IOF_VOLATILE (1 << 7) + #define HID_IOF_NON_VOLATILE (0 << 7) + #define HID_IOF_BUFFERED_BYTES (1 << 8) + #define HID_IOF_BITFIELD (0 << 8) + //@} + + /** \name HID Report Descriptor Item Macros */ + //@{ + #define HID_RI_INPUT(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_MAIN , 0x80, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + #define HID_RI_OUTPUT(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_MAIN , 0x90, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + #define HID_RI_COLLECTION(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_MAIN , 0xA0, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + #define HID_RI_FEATURE(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_MAIN , 0xB0, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + #define HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_MAIN , 0xC0, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + #define HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_GLOBAL, 0x00, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + #define HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_GLOBAL, 0x10, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + #define HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_GLOBAL, 0x20, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + #define HID_RI_PHYSICAL_MINIMUM(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_GLOBAL, 0x30, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + #define HID_RI_PHYSICAL_MAXIMUM(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_GLOBAL, 0x40, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + #define HID_RI_UNIT_EXPONENT(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_GLOBAL, 0x50, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + #define HID_RI_UNIT(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_GLOBAL, 0x60, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + #define HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_GLOBAL, 0x70, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + #define HID_RI_REPORT_ID(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_GLOBAL, 0x80, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + #define HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_GLOBAL, 0x90, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + #define HID_RI_PUSH(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_GLOBAL, 0xA0, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + #define HID_RI_POP(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_GLOBAL, 0xB0, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + #define HID_RI_USAGE(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_LOCAL , 0x00, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + #define HID_RI_USAGE_MINIMUM(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_LOCAL , 0x10, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + #define HID_RI_USAGE_MAXIMUM(DataBits, ...) _HID_RI_ENTRY(HID_RI_TYPE_LOCAL , 0x20, DataBits, __VA_ARGS__) + //@} + +/** @} */ + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/MIDIClassCommon.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/MIDIClassCommon.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b6414bc06b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/MIDIClassCommon.h @@ -0,0 +1,363 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Common definitions and declarations for the library USB MIDI Class driver. + * + * Common definitions and declarations for the library USB MIDI Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassMIDI + * \defgroup Group_USBClassMIDICommon Common Class Definitions + * + * \section Sec_USBClassMIDICommon_ModDescription Module Description + * Constants, Types and Enum definitions that are common to both Device and Host modes for the USB + * MIDI Class. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _MIDI_CLASS_COMMON_H_ +#define _MIDI_CLASS_COMMON_H_ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_AUDIO_DRIVER + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Core/StdDescriptors.h" + #include "AudioClassCommon.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_MIDI_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** \name MIDI Command Values + * See http://www.midi.org/techspecs/midimessages.php for more information. + */ + //@{ + /** MIDI command for System Exclusive (SysEx) single event that has one byte of data total. */ + #define MIDI_COMMAND_SYSEX_1BYTE MIDI_COMMAND_SYSEX_END_1BYTE + + /** MIDI command for System Exclusive (SysEx) single event that has two bytes of data total. */ + #define MIDI_COMMAND_SYSEX_2BYTE 0x20 + + /** MIDI command for System Exclusive (SysEx) single event that has three bytes of data total. */ + #define MIDI_COMMAND_SYSEX_3BYTE 0x30 + + /** MIDI command for System Exclusive (SysEx) stream event that has at least four bytes of data total. */ + #define MIDI_COMMAND_SYSEX_START_3BYTE 0x40 + + /** MIDI command for System Exclusive (SysEx) stream event terminator with one remaining data byte. */ + #define MIDI_COMMAND_SYSEX_END_1BYTE 0x50 + + /** MIDI command for System Exclusive (SysEx) stream event terminator with two remaining data bytes. */ + #define MIDI_COMMAND_SYSEX_END_2BYTE 0x60 + + /** MIDI command for System Exclusive (SysEx) stream event terminator with three remaining data bytes. */ + #define MIDI_COMMAND_SYSEX_END_3BYTE 0x70 + + /** MIDI command for a note off (deactivation) event. */ + #define MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF 0x80 + + /** MIDI command for a note on (activation) event. */ + #define MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON 0x90 + + /** MIDI command for a note pressure change event. */ + #define MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_PRESSURE 0xA0 + + /** MIDI command for a control change event. */ + #define MIDI_COMMAND_CONTROL_CHANGE 0xB0 + + /** MIDI command for a control change event. */ + #define MIDI_COMMAND_PROGRAM_CHANGE 0xC0 + + /** MIDI command for a channel pressure change event. */ + #define MIDI_COMMAND_CHANNEL_PRESSURE 0xD0 + + /** MIDI command for a pitch change event. */ + #define MIDI_COMMAND_PITCH_WHEEL_CHANGE 0xE0 + //@} + + /** Standard key press velocity value used for all note events. */ + #define MIDI_STANDARD_VELOCITY 64 + + /** Convenience macro. MIDI channels are numbered from 1-10 (natural numbers) however the logical channel + * addresses are zero-indexed. This converts a natural MIDI channel number into the logical channel address. + * + * \param[in] channel MIDI channel number to address. + * + * \return Constructed MIDI channel ID. + */ + #define MIDI_CHANNEL(channel) ((channel) - 1) + + /** Constructs a MIDI event ID from a given MIDI command and a virtual MIDI cable index. This can then be + * used to create and decode \ref MIDI_EventPacket_t MIDI event packets. + * + * \param[in] virtualcable Index of the virtual MIDI cable the event relates to + * \param[in] command MIDI command to send through the virtual MIDI cable + * + * \return Constructed MIDI event ID. + */ + #define MIDI_EVENT(virtualcable, command) (((virtualcable) << 4) | ((command) >> 4)) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible MIDI jack types in a MIDI device jack descriptor. */ + enum MIDI_JackTypes_t + { + MIDI_JACKTYPE_Embedded = 0x01, /**< MIDI class descriptor jack type value for an embedded (logical) MIDI input or output jack. */ + MIDI_JACKTYPE_External = 0x02, /**< MIDI class descriptor jack type value for an external (physical) MIDI input or output jack. */ + }; + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief MIDI class-specific Streaming Interface Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific MIDI streaming interface descriptor. This indicates to the host + * how MIDI the specification compliance of the device and the total length of the Audio class-specific descriptors. + * See the USB Audio specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_MIDI_StdDescriptor_AudioInterface_AS_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length. */ + uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors. */ + + uint16_t AudioSpecification; /**< Binary coded decimal value, indicating the supported Audio Class + * specification version. + * + * \see \ref VERSION_BCD() utility macro. + */ + uint16_t TotalLength; /**< Total length of the Audio class-specific descriptors, including this descriptor. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_MIDI_Descriptor_AudioInterface_AS_t; + + /** \brief MIDI class-specific Streaming Interface Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific MIDI streaming interface descriptor. This indicates to the host + * how MIDI the specification compliance of the device and the total length of the Audio class-specific descriptors. + * See the USB Audio specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_MIDI_Descriptor_AudioInterface_AS_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific + * element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + + uint8_t bDescriptorSubtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors. */ + + uint16_t bcdMSC; /**< Binary coded decimal value, indicating the supported MIDI Class specification version. + * + * \see \ref VERSION_BCD() utility macro. + */ + uint16_t wTotalLength; /**< Total length of the Audio class-specific descriptors, including this descriptor. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_MIDI_StdDescriptor_AudioInterface_AS_t; + + /** \brief MIDI class-specific Input Jack Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific MIDI IN jack. This gives information to the host on a MIDI input, either + * a physical input jack, or a logical jack (receiving input data internally, or from the host via an endpoint). + * + * \see \ref USB_MIDI_StdDescriptor_InputJack_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length. */ + uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors. */ + + uint8_t JackType; /**< Type of jack, one of the \c JACKTYPE_* mask values. */ + uint8_t JackID; /**< ID value of this jack - must be a unique value within the device. */ + + uint8_t JackStrIndex; /**< Index of a string descriptor describing this descriptor within the device. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t; + + /** \brief MIDI class-specific Input Jack Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific MIDI IN jack. This gives information to the host on a MIDI input, either + * a physical input jack, or a logical jack (receiving input data internally, or from the host via an endpoint). + * + * \see \ref USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific + * element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + + uint8_t bDescriptorSubtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors. */ + + uint8_t bJackType; /**< Type of jack, one of the \c JACKTYPE_* mask values. */ + uint8_t bJackID; /**< ID value of this jack - must be a unique value within the device. */ + + uint8_t iJack; /**< Index of a string descriptor describing this descriptor within the device. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_MIDI_StdDescriptor_InputJack_t; + + /** \brief MIDI class-specific Output Jack Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific MIDI OUT jack. This gives information to the host on a MIDI output, either + * a physical output jack, or a logical jack (sending output data internally, or to the host via an endpoint). + * + * \see \ref USB_MIDI_StdDescriptor_OutputJack_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length. */ + uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors. */ + + uint8_t JackType; /**< Type of jack, one of the \c JACKTYPE_* mask values. */ + uint8_t JackID; /**< ID value of this jack - must be a unique value within the device. */ + + uint8_t NumberOfPins; /**< Number of output channels within the jack, either physical or logical. */ + uint8_t SourceJackID[1]; /**< ID of each output pin's source data jack. */ + uint8_t SourcePinID[1]; /**< Pin number in the input jack of each output pin's source data. */ + + uint8_t JackStrIndex; /**< Index of a string descriptor describing this descriptor within the device. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t; + + /** \brief MIDI class-specific Output Jack Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific MIDI OUT jack. This gives information to the host on a MIDI output, either + * a physical output jack, or a logical jack (sending output data internally, or to the host via an endpoint). + * + * \see \ref USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific + * element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + + uint8_t bDescriptorSubtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors. */ + + uint8_t bJackType; /**< Type of jack, one of the \c JACKTYPE_* mask values. */ + uint8_t bJackID; /**< ID value of this jack - must be a unique value within the device. */ + + uint8_t bNrInputPins; /**< Number of output channels within the jack, either physical or logical. */ + uint8_t baSourceID[1]; /**< ID of each output pin's source data jack. */ + uint8_t baSourcePin[1]; /**< Pin number in the input jack of each output pin's source data. */ + + uint8_t iJack; /**< Index of a string descriptor describing this descriptor within the device. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_MIDI_StdDescriptor_OutputJack_t; + + /** \brief Audio class-specific Jack Endpoint Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific extended MIDI jack endpoint descriptor. This contains extra information + * on the usage of MIDI endpoints used to stream MIDI events in and out of the USB Audio device, and follows an Audio + * class-specific extended MIDI endpoint descriptor. See the USB Audio specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_MIDI_StdDescriptor_Jack_Endpoint_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length. */ + uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors. */ + + uint8_t TotalEmbeddedJacks; /**< Total number of jacks inside this endpoint. */ + uint8_t AssociatedJackID[1]; /**< IDs of each jack inside the endpoint. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_MIDI_Descriptor_Jack_Endpoint_t; + + /** \brief Audio class-specific Jack Endpoint Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for an Audio class-specific extended MIDI jack endpoint descriptor. This contains extra information + * on the usage of MIDI endpoints used to stream MIDI events in and out of the USB Audio device, and follows an Audio + * class-specific extended MIDI endpoint descriptor. See the USB Audio specification for more details. + * + * \see \ref USB_MIDI_Descriptor_Jack_Endpoint_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific + * element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + + uint8_t bDescriptorSubtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class-specific descriptors. */ + + uint8_t bNumEmbMIDIJack; /**< Total number of jacks inside this endpoint. */ + uint8_t bAssocJackID[1]; /**< IDs of each jack inside the endpoint. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_MIDI_StdDescriptor_Jack_Endpoint_t; + + /** \brief MIDI Class Driver Event Packet. + * + * Type define for a USB MIDI event packet, used to encapsulate sent and received MIDI messages from a USB MIDI interface. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Event; /**< MIDI event type, constructed with the \ref MIDI_EVENT() macro. */ + + uint8_t Data1; /**< First byte of data in the MIDI event. */ + uint8_t Data2; /**< Second byte of data in the MIDI event. */ + uint8_t Data3; /**< Third byte of data in the MIDI event. */ + } ATTR_PACKED MIDI_EventPacket_t; + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/MassStorageClassCommon.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/MassStorageClassCommon.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d2ea37a82a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/MassStorageClassCommon.h @@ -0,0 +1,368 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Common definitions and declarations for the library USB Mass Storage Class driver. + * + * Common definitions and declarations for the library USB Mass Storage Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassMS + * \defgroup Group_USBClassMSCommon Common Class Definitions + * + * \section Sec_USBClassMSCommon_ModDescription Module Description + * Constants, Types and Enum definitions that are common to both Device and Host modes for the USB + * Mass Storage Class. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _MS_CLASS_COMMON_H_ +#define _MS_CLASS_COMMON_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Core/StdDescriptors.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_MS_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** Magic signature for a Command Block Wrapper used in the Mass Storage Bulk-Only transport protocol. */ + #define MS_CBW_SIGNATURE 0x43425355UL + + /** Magic signature for a Command Status Wrapper used in the Mass Storage Bulk-Only transport protocol. */ + #define MS_CSW_SIGNATURE 0x53425355UL + + /** Mask for a Command Block Wrapper's flags attribute to specify a command with data sent from host-to-device. */ + #define MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_OUT (0 << 7) + + /** Mask for a Command Block Wrapper's flags attribute to specify a command with data sent from device-to-host. */ + #define MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_IN (1 << 7) + + /** \name SCSI Commands*/ + //@{ + /** SCSI Command Code for an INQUIRY command. */ + #define SCSI_CMD_INQUIRY 0x12 + + /** SCSI Command Code for a REQUEST SENSE command. */ + #define SCSI_CMD_REQUEST_SENSE 0x03 + + /** SCSI Command Code for a TEST UNIT READY command. */ + #define SCSI_CMD_TEST_UNIT_READY 0x00 + + /** SCSI Command Code for a READ CAPACITY (10) command. */ + #define SCSI_CMD_READ_CAPACITY_10 0x25 + + /** SCSI Command Code for a START STOP UNIT command. */ + #define SCSI_CMD_START_STOP_UNIT 0x1B + + /** SCSI Command Code for a SEND DIAGNOSTIC command. */ + #define SCSI_CMD_SEND_DIAGNOSTIC 0x1D + + /** SCSI Command Code for a PREVENT ALLOW MEDIUM REMOVAL command. */ + #define SCSI_CMD_PREVENT_ALLOW_MEDIUM_REMOVAL 0x1E + + /** SCSI Command Code for a WRITE (10) command. */ + #define SCSI_CMD_WRITE_10 0x2A + + /** SCSI Command Code for a READ (10) command. */ + #define SCSI_CMD_READ_10 0x28 + + /** SCSI Command Code for a WRITE (6) command. */ + #define SCSI_CMD_WRITE_6 0x0A + + /** SCSI Command Code for a READ (6) command. */ + #define SCSI_CMD_READ_6 0x08 + + /** SCSI Command Code for a VERIFY (10) command. */ + #define SCSI_CMD_VERIFY_10 0x2F + + /** SCSI Command Code for a MODE SENSE (6) command. */ + #define SCSI_CMD_MODE_SENSE_6 0x1A + + /** SCSI Command Code for a MODE SENSE (10) command. */ + #define SCSI_CMD_MODE_SENSE_10 0x5A + //@} + + /** \name SCSI Sense Key Values */ + //@{ + /** SCSI Sense Code to indicate no error has occurred. */ + #define SCSI_SENSE_KEY_GOOD 0x00 + + /** SCSI Sense Code to indicate that the device has recovered from an error. */ + #define SCSI_SENSE_KEY_RECOVERED_ERROR 0x01 + + /** SCSI Sense Code to indicate that the device is not ready for a new command. */ + #define SCSI_SENSE_KEY_NOT_READY 0x02 + + /** SCSI Sense Code to indicate an error whilst accessing the medium. */ + #define SCSI_SENSE_KEY_MEDIUM_ERROR 0x03 + + /** SCSI Sense Code to indicate a hardware error has occurred. */ + #define SCSI_SENSE_KEY_HARDWARE_ERROR 0x04 + + /** SCSI Sense Code to indicate that an illegal request has been issued. */ + #define SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST 0x05 + + /** SCSI Sense Code to indicate that the unit requires attention from the host to indicate + * a reset event, medium removal or other condition. + */ + #define SCSI_SENSE_KEY_UNIT_ATTENTION 0x06 + + /** SCSI Sense Code to indicate that a write attempt on a protected block has been made. */ + #define SCSI_SENSE_KEY_DATA_PROTECT 0x07 + + /** SCSI Sense Code to indicate an error while trying to write to a write-once medium. */ + #define SCSI_SENSE_KEY_BLANK_CHECK 0x08 + + /** SCSI Sense Code to indicate a vendor specific error has occurred. */ + #define SCSI_SENSE_KEY_VENDOR_SPECIFIC 0x09 + + /** SCSI Sense Code to indicate that an EXTENDED COPY command has aborted due to an error. */ + #define SCSI_SENSE_KEY_COPY_ABORTED 0x0A + + /** SCSI Sense Code to indicate that the device has aborted the issued command. */ + #define SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ABORTED_COMMAND 0x0B + + /** SCSI Sense Code to indicate an attempt to write past the end of a partition has been made. */ + #define SCSI_SENSE_KEY_VOLUME_OVERFLOW 0x0D + + /** SCSI Sense Code to indicate that the source data did not match the data read from the medium. */ + #define SCSI_SENSE_KEY_MISCOMPARE 0x0E + //@} + + /** \name SCSI Additional Sense Codes */ + //@{ + /** SCSI Additional Sense Code to indicate no additional sense information is available. */ + #define SCSI_ASENSE_NO_ADDITIONAL_INFORMATION 0x00 + + /** SCSI Additional Sense Code to indicate that the logical unit (LUN) addressed is not ready. */ + #define SCSI_ASENSE_LOGICAL_UNIT_NOT_READY 0x04 + + /** SCSI Additional Sense Code to indicate an invalid field was encountered while processing the issued command. */ + #define SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_FIELD_IN_CDB 0x24 + + /** SCSI Additional Sense Code to indicate that a medium that was previously indicated as not ready has now + * become ready for use. + */ + #define SCSI_ASENSE_NOT_READY_TO_READY_CHANGE 0x28 + + /** SCSI Additional Sense Code to indicate that an attempt to write to a protected area was made. */ + #define SCSI_ASENSE_WRITE_PROTECTED 0x27 + + /** SCSI Additional Sense Code to indicate an error whilst formatting the device medium. */ + #define SCSI_ASENSE_FORMAT_ERROR 0x31 + + /** SCSI Additional Sense Code to indicate an invalid command was issued. */ + #define SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_COMMAND 0x20 + + /** SCSI Additional Sense Code to indicate a write to a block out outside of the medium's range was issued. */ + #define SCSI_ASENSE_LOGICAL_BLOCK_ADDRESS_OUT_OF_RANGE 0x21 + + /** SCSI Additional Sense Code to indicate that no removable medium is inserted into the device. */ + #define SCSI_ASENSE_MEDIUM_NOT_PRESENT 0x3A + //@} + + /** \name SCSI Additional Sense Key Code Qualifiers */ + //@{ + /** SCSI Additional Sense Qualifier Code to indicate no additional sense qualifier information is available. */ + #define SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER 0x00 + + /** SCSI Additional Sense Qualifier Code to indicate that a medium format command failed to complete. */ + #define SCSI_ASENSEQ_FORMAT_COMMAND_FAILED 0x01 + + /** SCSI Additional Sense Qualifier Code to indicate that an initializing command must be issued before the issued + * command can be executed. + */ + #define SCSI_ASENSEQ_INITIALIZING_COMMAND_REQUIRED 0x02 + + /** SCSI Additional Sense Qualifier Code to indicate that an operation is currently in progress. */ + #define SCSI_ASENSEQ_OPERATION_IN_PROGRESS 0x07 + //@} + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for possible Class, Subclass and Protocol values of device and interface descriptors relating to the Mass + * Storage device class. + */ + enum MS_Descriptor_ClassSubclassProtocol_t + { + MS_CSCP_MassStorageClass = 0x08, /**< Descriptor Class value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to the Mass Storage class. + */ + MS_CSCP_SCSITransparentSubclass = 0x06, /**< Descriptor Subclass value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to the SCSI Transparent Command Set subclass of the Mass + * storage class. + */ + MS_CSCP_BulkOnlyTransportProtocol = 0x50, /**< Descriptor Protocol value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to the Bulk Only Transport protocol of the Mass Storage class. + */ + }; + + /** Enum for the Mass Storage class specific control requests that can be issued by the USB bus host. */ + enum MS_ClassRequests_t + { + MS_REQ_GetMaxLUN = 0xFE, /**< Mass Storage class-specific request to retrieve the total number of Logical + * Units (drives) in the SCSI device. + */ + MS_REQ_MassStorageReset = 0xFF, /**< Mass Storage class-specific request to reset the Mass Storage interface, + * ready for the next command. + */ + }; + + /** Enum for the possible command status wrapper return status codes. */ + enum MS_CommandStatusCodes_t + { + MS_SCSI_COMMAND_Pass = 0, /**< Command completed with no error */ + MS_SCSI_COMMAND_Fail = 1, /**< Command failed to complete - host may check the exact error via a + * SCSI REQUEST SENSE command. + */ + MS_SCSI_COMMAND_PhaseError = 2, /**< Command failed due to being invalid in the current phase. */ + }; + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief Mass Storage Class Command Block Wrapper. + * + * Type define for a Command Block Wrapper, used in the Mass Storage Bulk-Only Transport protocol. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t Signature; /**< Command block signature, must be \ref MS_CBW_SIGNATURE to indicate a valid Command Block. */ + uint32_t Tag; /**< Unique command ID value, to associate a command block wrapper with its command status wrapper. */ + uint32_t DataTransferLength; /**< Length of the optional data portion of the issued command, in bytes. */ + uint8_t Flags; /**< Command block flags, indicating command data direction. */ + uint8_t LUN; /**< Logical Unit number this command is issued to. */ + uint8_t SCSICommandLength; /**< Length of the issued SCSI command within the SCSI command data array. */ + uint8_t SCSICommandData[16]; /**< Issued SCSI command in the Command Block. */ + } ATTR_PACKED MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t; + + /** \brief Mass Storage Class Command Status Wrapper. + * + * Type define for a Command Status Wrapper, used in the Mass Storage Bulk-Only Transport protocol. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t Signature; /**< Status block signature, must be \ref MS_CSW_SIGNATURE to indicate a valid Command Status. */ + uint32_t Tag; /**< Unique command ID value, to associate a command block wrapper with its command status wrapper. */ + uint32_t DataTransferResidue; /**< Number of bytes of data not processed in the SCSI command. */ + uint8_t Status; /**< Status code of the issued command - a value from the \ref MS_CommandStatusCodes_t enum. */ + } ATTR_PACKED MS_CommandStatusWrapper_t; + + /** \brief Mass Storage Class SCSI Sense Structure + * + * Type define for a SCSI Sense structure. Structures of this type are filled out by the + * device via the \ref MS_Host_RequestSense() function, indicating the current sense data of the + * device (giving explicit error codes for the last issued command). For details of the + * structure contents, refer to the SCSI specifications. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t ResponseCode; + + uint8_t SegmentNumber; + + unsigned SenseKey : 4; + unsigned Reserved : 1; + unsigned ILI : 1; + unsigned EOM : 1; + unsigned FileMark : 1; + + uint8_t Information[4]; + uint8_t AdditionalLength; + uint8_t CmdSpecificInformation[4]; + uint8_t AdditionalSenseCode; + uint8_t AdditionalSenseQualifier; + uint8_t FieldReplaceableUnitCode; + uint8_t SenseKeySpecific[3]; + } ATTR_PACKED SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t; + + /** \brief Mass Storage Class SCSI Inquiry Structure. + * + * Type define for a SCSI Inquiry structure. Structures of this type are filled out by the + * device via the \ref MS_Host_GetInquiryData() function, retrieving the attached device's + * information. + * + * For details of the structure contents, refer to the SCSI specifications. + */ + typedef struct + { + unsigned DeviceType : 5; + unsigned PeripheralQualifier : 3; + + unsigned Reserved : 7; + unsigned Removable : 1; + + uint8_t Version; + + unsigned ResponseDataFormat : 4; + unsigned Reserved2 : 1; + unsigned NormACA : 1; + unsigned TrmTsk : 1; + unsigned AERC : 1; + + uint8_t AdditionalLength; + uint8_t Reserved3[2]; + + unsigned SoftReset : 1; + unsigned CmdQue : 1; + unsigned Reserved4 : 1; + unsigned Linked : 1; + unsigned Sync : 1; + unsigned WideBus16Bit : 1; + unsigned WideBus32Bit : 1; + unsigned RelAddr : 1; + + uint8_t VendorID[8]; + uint8_t ProductID[16]; + uint8_t RevisionID[4]; + } ATTR_PACKED SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t; + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/PrinterClassCommon.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/PrinterClassCommon.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2db830e048 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/PrinterClassCommon.h @@ -0,0 +1,119 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Common definitions and declarations for the library USB Printer Class driver. + * + * Common definitions and declarations for the library USB Printer Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassPrinter + * \defgroup Group_USBClassPrinterCommon Common Class Definitions + * + * \section Sec_USBClassPrinterCommon_ModDescription Module Description + * Constants, Types and Enum definitions that are common to both Device and Host modes for the USB + * Printer Class. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _PRINTER_CLASS_COMMON_H_ +#define _PRINTER_CLASS_COMMON_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Core/StdDescriptors.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_PRINTER_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** \name Virtual Printer Status Line Masks */ + //@{ + /** Port status mask for a printer device, indicating that an error has *not* occurred. */ + #define PRNT_PORTSTATUS_NOTERROR (1 << 3) + + /** Port status mask for a printer device, indicating that the device is currently selected. */ + #define PRNT_PORTSTATUS_SELECT (1 << 4) + + /** Port status mask for a printer device, indicating that the device is currently out of paper. */ + #define PRNT_PORTSTATUS_PAPEREMPTY (1 << 5) + //@} + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for possible Class, Subclass and Protocol values of device and interface descriptors relating to the Printer + * device class. + */ + enum PRNT_Descriptor_ClassSubclassProtocol_t + { + PRNT_CSCP_PrinterClass = 0x07, /**< Descriptor Class value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to the Printer class. + */ + PRNT_CSCP_PrinterSubclass = 0x01, /**< Descriptor Subclass value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to the Printer subclass. + */ + PRNT_CSCP_BidirectionalProtocol = 0x02, /**< Descriptor Protocol value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to the Bidirectional protocol of the Printer class. + */ + }; + + /** Enum for the Printer class specific control requests that can be issued by the USB bus host. */ + enum PRNT_ClassRequests_t + { + PRNT_REQ_GetDeviceID = 0x00, /**< Printer class-specific request to retrieve the Unicode ID + * string of the device, containing the device's name, manufacturer + * and supported printer languages. + */ + PRNT_REQ_GetPortStatus = 0x01, /**< Printer class-specific request to get the current status of the + * virtual printer port, for device selection and ready states. + */ + PRNT_REQ_SoftReset = 0x02, /**< Printer class-specific request to reset the device, ready for new + * printer commands. + */ + }; + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/RNDISClassCommon.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/RNDISClassCommon.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ade1af0673 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/RNDISClassCommon.h @@ -0,0 +1,411 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Common definitions and declarations for the library USB RNDIS Class driver. + * + * Common definitions and declarations for the library USB RNDIS Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassRNDIS + * \defgroup Group_USBClassRNDISCommon Common Class Definitions + * + * \section Sec_USBClassRNDISCommon_ModDescription Module Description + * Constants, Types and Enum definitions that are common to both Device and Host modes for the USB + * RNDIS Class. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _RNDIS_CLASS_COMMON_H_ +#define _RNDIS_CLASS_COMMON_H_ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_CDC_DRIVER + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Core/StdDescriptors.h" + #include "CDCClassCommon.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_RNDIS_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** Additional error code for RNDIS functions when a device returns a logical command failure. */ + #define RNDIS_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED 0x80 + + /** Implemented RNDIS Version Major. */ + #define REMOTE_NDIS_VERSION_MAJOR 0x01 + + /** Implemented RNDIS Version Minor. */ + #define REMOTE_NDIS_VERSION_MINOR 0x00 + + /** \name RNDIS Message Values */ + //@{ + #define REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_MSG 0x00000001UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_INITIALIZE_MSG 0x00000002UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_HALT_MSG 0x00000003UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_QUERY_MSG 0x00000004UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_SET_MSG 0x00000005UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_RESET_MSG 0x00000006UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_INDICATE_STATUS_MSG 0x00000007UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_KEEPALIVE_MSG 0x00000008UL + //@} + + /** \name RNDIS Response Values */ + //@{ + #define REMOTE_NDIS_INITIALIZE_CMPLT 0x80000002UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_QUERY_CMPLT 0x80000004UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_SET_CMPLT 0x80000005UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_RESET_CMPLT 0x80000006UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_KEEPALIVE_CMPLT 0x80000008UL + //@} + + /** \name RNDIS Status Values */ + //@{ + #define REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_SUCCESS 0x00000000UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_FAILURE 0xC0000001UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_INVALID_DATA 0xC0010015UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_NOT_SUPPORTED 0xC00000BBUL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_MEDIA_CONNECT 0x4001000BUL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_MEDIA_DISCONNECT 0x4001000CUL + //@} + + /** \name RNDIS Media States */ + //@{ + #define REMOTE_NDIS_MEDIA_STATE_CONNECTED 0x00000000UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_MEDIA_STATE_DISCONNECTED 0x00000001UL + //@} + + /** \name RNDIS Media Types */ + //@{ + #define REMOTE_NDIS_MEDIUM_802_3 0x00000000UL + //@} + + /** \name RNDIS Connection Types */ + //@{ + #define REMOTE_NDIS_DF_CONNECTIONLESS 0x00000001UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_DF_CONNECTION_ORIENTED 0x00000002UL + //@} + + /** \name RNDIS Packet Types */ + //@{ + #define REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_DIRECTED 0x00000001UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_MULTICAST 0x00000002UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_ALL_MULTICAST 0x00000004UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_BROADCAST 0x00000008UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_SOURCE_ROUTING 0x00000010UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_PROMISCUOUS 0x00000020UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_SMT 0x00000040UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_ALL_LOCAL 0x00000080UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_GROUP 0x00001000UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_ALL_FUNCTIONAL 0x00002000UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_FUNCTIONAL 0x00004000UL + #define REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_MAC_FRAME 0x00008000UL + //@} + + /** \name RNDIS OID Values */ + //@{ + #define OID_GEN_SUPPORTED_LIST 0x00010101UL + #define OID_GEN_HARDWARE_STATUS 0x00010102UL + #define OID_GEN_MEDIA_SUPPORTED 0x00010103UL + #define OID_GEN_MEDIA_IN_USE 0x00010104UL + #define OID_GEN_MAXIMUM_FRAME_SIZE 0x00010106UL + #define OID_GEN_MAXIMUM_TOTAL_SIZE 0x00010111UL + #define OID_GEN_LINK_SPEED 0x00010107UL + #define OID_GEN_TRANSMIT_BLOCK_SIZE 0x0001010AUL + #define OID_GEN_RECEIVE_BLOCK_SIZE 0x0001010BUL + #define OID_GEN_VENDOR_ID 0x0001010CUL + #define OID_GEN_VENDOR_DESCRIPTION 0x0001010DUL + #define OID_GEN_CURRENT_PACKET_FILTER 0x0001010EUL + #define OID_GEN_MAXIMUM_TOTAL_SIZE 0x00010111UL + #define OID_GEN_MEDIA_CONNECT_STATUS 0x00010114UL + #define OID_GEN_PHYSICAL_MEDIUM 0x00010202UL + #define OID_GEN_XMIT_OK 0x00020101UL + #define OID_GEN_RCV_OK 0x00020102UL + #define OID_GEN_XMIT_ERROR 0x00020103UL + #define OID_GEN_RCV_ERROR 0x00020104UL + #define OID_GEN_RCV_NO_BUFFER 0x00020105UL + #define OID_802_3_PERMANENT_ADDRESS 0x01010101UL + #define OID_802_3_CURRENT_ADDRESS 0x01010102UL + #define OID_802_3_MULTICAST_LIST 0x01010103UL + #define OID_802_3_MAXIMUM_LIST_SIZE 0x01010104UL + #define OID_802_3_RCV_ERROR_ALIGNMENT 0x01020101UL + #define OID_802_3_XMIT_ONE_COLLISION 0x01020102UL + #define OID_802_3_XMIT_MORE_COLLISIONS 0x01020103UL + //@} + + /** Maximum size in bytes of an Ethernet frame according to the Ethernet standard. */ + #define ETHERNET_FRAME_SIZE_MAX 1500 + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the RNDIS class specific control requests that can be issued by the USB bus host. */ + enum RNDIS_ClassRequests_t + { + RNDIS_REQ_SendEncapsulatedCommand = 0x00, /**< RNDIS request to issue a host-to-device NDIS command. */ + RNDIS_REQ_GetEncapsulatedResponse = 0x01, /**< RNDIS request to issue a device-to-host NDIS response. */ + }; + + /** Enum for the possible NDIS adapter states. */ + enum RNDIS_States_t + { + RNDIS_Uninitialized = 0, /**< Adapter currently uninitialized. */ + RNDIS_Initialized = 1, /**< Adapter currently initialized but not ready for data transfers. */ + RNDIS_Data_Initialized = 2, /**< Adapter currently initialized and ready for data transfers. */ + }; + + /** Enum for the RNDIS class specific notification requests that can be issued by a RNDIS device to a host. */ + enum RNDIS_ClassNotifications_t + { + RNDIS_NOTIF_ResponseAvailable = 0x01, /**< Notification request value for a RNDIS Response Available notification. */ + }; + + /** Enum for the NDIS hardware states. */ + enum NDIS_Hardware_Status_t + { + NDIS_HardwareStatus_Ready, /**< Hardware Ready to accept commands from the host. */ + NDIS_HardwareStatus_Initializing, /**< Hardware busy initializing. */ + NDIS_HardwareStatus_Reset, /**< Hardware reset. */ + NDIS_HardwareStatus_Closing, /**< Hardware currently closing. */ + NDIS_HardwareStatus_NotReady /**< Hardware not ready to accept commands from the host. */ + }; + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief MAC Address Structure. + * + * Type define for a physical MAC address of a device on a network. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Octets[6]; /**< Individual bytes of a MAC address */ + } ATTR_PACKED MAC_Address_t; + + /** \brief RNDIS Common Message Header Structure. + * + * Type define for a RNDIS message header, sent before RNDIS messages. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t MessageType; /**< RNDIS message type, a \c REMOTE_NDIS_*_MSG constant */ + uint32_t MessageLength; /**< Total length of the RNDIS message, in bytes */ + } ATTR_PACKED RNDIS_Message_Header_t; + + /** \brief RNDIS Message Structure. + * + * Type define for a RNDIS packet message, used to encapsulate Ethernet packets sent to and from the adapter. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t MessageType; + uint32_t MessageLength; + uint32_t DataOffset; + uint32_t DataLength; + uint32_t OOBDataOffset; + uint32_t OOBDataLength; + uint32_t NumOOBDataElements; + uint32_t PerPacketInfoOffset; + uint32_t PerPacketInfoLength; + uint32_t VcHandle; + uint32_t Reserved; + } ATTR_PACKED RNDIS_Packet_Message_t; + + /** \brief RNDIS Initialization Message Structure. + * + * Type define for a RNDIS Initialize command message. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t MessageType; + uint32_t MessageLength; + uint32_t RequestId; + + uint32_t MajorVersion; + uint32_t MinorVersion; + uint32_t MaxTransferSize; + } ATTR_PACKED RNDIS_Initialize_Message_t; + + /** \brief RNDIS Initialize Complete Message Structure. + * + * Type define for a RNDIS Initialize Complete response message. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t MessageType; + uint32_t MessageLength; + uint32_t RequestId; + uint32_t Status; + + uint32_t MajorVersion; + uint32_t MinorVersion; + uint32_t DeviceFlags; + uint32_t Medium; + uint32_t MaxPacketsPerTransfer; + uint32_t MaxTransferSize; + uint32_t PacketAlignmentFactor; + uint32_t AFListOffset; + uint32_t AFListSize; + } ATTR_PACKED RNDIS_Initialize_Complete_t; + + /** \brief RNDIS Keep Alive Message Structure. + * + * Type define for a RNDIS Keep Alive command message. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t MessageType; + uint32_t MessageLength; + uint32_t RequestId; + } ATTR_PACKED RNDIS_KeepAlive_Message_t; + + /** \brief RNDIS Keep Alive Complete Message Structure. + * + * Type define for a RNDIS Keep Alive Complete response message. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t MessageType; + uint32_t MessageLength; + uint32_t RequestId; + uint32_t Status; + } ATTR_PACKED RNDIS_KeepAlive_Complete_t; + + /** \brief RNDIS Reset Complete Message Structure. + * + * Type define for a RNDIS Reset Complete response message. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t MessageType; + uint32_t MessageLength; + uint32_t Status; + + uint32_t AddressingReset; + } ATTR_PACKED RNDIS_Reset_Complete_t; + + /** \brief RNDIS OID Property Set Message Structure. + * + * Type define for a RNDIS OID Property Set command message. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t MessageType; + uint32_t MessageLength; + uint32_t RequestId; + + uint32_t Oid; + uint32_t InformationBufferLength; + uint32_t InformationBufferOffset; + uint32_t DeviceVcHandle; + } ATTR_PACKED RNDIS_Set_Message_t; + + /** \brief RNDIS OID Property Set Complete Message Structure. + * + * Type define for a RNDIS OID Property Set Complete response message. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t MessageType; + uint32_t MessageLength; + uint32_t RequestId; + uint32_t Status; + } ATTR_PACKED RNDIS_Set_Complete_t; + + /** \brief RNDIS OID Property Query Message Structure. + * + * Type define for a RNDIS OID Property Query command message. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t MessageType; + uint32_t MessageLength; + uint32_t RequestId; + + uint32_t Oid; + uint32_t InformationBufferLength; + uint32_t InformationBufferOffset; + uint32_t DeviceVcHandle; + } ATTR_PACKED RNDIS_Query_Message_t; + + /** \brief RNDIS OID Property Query Complete Message Structure. + * + * Type define for a RNDIS OID Property Query Complete response message. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t MessageType; + uint32_t MessageLength; + uint32_t RequestId; + uint32_t Status; + + uint32_t InformationBufferLength; + uint32_t InformationBufferOffset; + } ATTR_PACKED RNDIS_Query_Complete_t; + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/StillImageClassCommon.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/StillImageClassCommon.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7608b18cc4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/StillImageClassCommon.h @@ -0,0 +1,161 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Common definitions and declarations for the library USB Still Image Class driver. + * + * Common definitions and declarations for the library USB Still Image Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassSI + * \defgroup Group_USBClassSICommon Common Class Definitions + * + * \section Sec_USBClassSICommon_ModDescription Module Description + * Constants, Types and Enum definitions that are common to both Device and Host modes for the USB + * Still Image Class. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _SI_CLASS_COMMON_H_ +#define _SI_CLASS_COMMON_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Core/StdDescriptors.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_SI_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** Length in bytes of a given Unicode string's character length. + * + * \param[in] Chars Total number of Unicode characters in the string. + * + * \return Number of bytes of the given unicode string. + */ + #define UNICODE_STRING_LENGTH(Chars) ((Chars) << 1) + + /** Used in the DataLength field of a PIMA container, to give the total container size in bytes for + * a command container. + * + * \param[in] Params Number of parameters which are to be sent in the \c Param field of the container. + */ + #define PIMA_COMMAND_SIZE(Params) ((sizeof(PIMA_Container_t) - 12) + ((Params) * sizeof(uint32_t))) + + /** Used in the DataLength field of a PIMA container, to give the total container size in bytes for + * a data container. + * + * \param[in] DataLen Length in bytes of the data in the container. + */ + #define PIMA_DATA_SIZE(DataLen) ((sizeof(PIMA_Container_t) - 12) + (DataLen)) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible PIMA contains types. */ + enum PIMA_Container_Types_t + { + PIMA_CONTAINER_Undefined = 0, /**< Undefined container type. */ + PIMA_CONTAINER_CommandBlock = 1, /**< Command Block container type. */ + PIMA_CONTAINER_DataBlock = 2, /**< Data Block container type. */ + PIMA_CONTAINER_ResponseBlock = 3, /**< Response container type. */ + PIMA_CONTAINER_EventBlock = 4, /**< Event Block container type. */ + }; + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for possible Class, Subclass and Protocol values of device and interface descriptors relating to the + * Still Image device class. + */ + enum SI_Descriptor_ClassSubclassProtocol_t + { + SI_CSCP_StillImageClass = 0x06, /**< Descriptor Class value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to the Still Image class. + */ + SI_CSCP_StillImageSubclass = 0x01, /**< Descriptor Subclass value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to the Still Image subclass. + */ + SI_CSCP_BulkOnlyProtocol = 0x01, /**< Descriptor Protocol value indicating that the device or interface + * belongs to the Bulk Only Transport protocol of the Still Image class. + */ + }; + + /** Enums for the possible status codes of a returned Response Block from an attached PIMA compliant Still Image device. */ + enum PIMA_ResponseCodes_t + { + PIMA_RESPONSE_OK = 1, /**< Response code indicating no error in the issued command. */ + PIMA_RESPONSE_GeneralError = 2, /**< Response code indicating a general error while processing the + * issued command. + */ + PIMA_RESPONSE_SessionNotOpen = 3, /**< Response code indicating that the sent command requires an open + * session before being issued. + */ + PIMA_RESPONSE_InvalidTransaction = 4, /**< Response code indicating an invalid transaction occurred. */ + PIMA_RESPONSE_OperationNotSupported = 5, /**< Response code indicating that the issued command is not supported + * by the attached device. + */ + PIMA_RESPONSE_ParameterNotSupported = 6, /**< Response code indicating that one or more of the issued command's + * parameters are not supported by the device. + */ + }; + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief PIMA Still Image Device Command/Response Container. + * + * Type define for a PIMA container, use to send commands and receive responses to and from an + * attached Still Image device. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t DataLength; /**< Length of the container and data, in bytes. */ + uint16_t Type; /**< Container type, a value from the \ref PIMA_Container_Types_t enum. */ + uint16_t Code; /**< Command, event or response code of the container. */ + uint32_t TransactionID; /**< Unique container ID to link blocks together. */ + uint32_t Params[3]; /**< Block parameters to be issued along with the block code (command blocks only). */ + } ATTR_PACKED PIMA_Container_t; + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/AudioClassDevice.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/AudioClassDevice.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..08cbeb7061 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/AudioClassDevice.c @@ -0,0 +1,197 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../../Core/USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_AUDIO_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_AUDIO_DEVICE_C +#include "AudioClassDevice.h" + +void Audio_Device_ProcessControlRequest(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) +{ + if (!(Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived())) + return; + + if ((USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType & CONTROL_REQTYPE_RECIPIENT) == REQREC_INTERFACE) + { + uint8_t InterfaceIndex = (USB_ControlRequest.wIndex & 0xFF); + + if ((InterfaceIndex != AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.ControlInterfaceNumber) && + (InterfaceIndex != AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.StreamingInterfaceNumber)) + { + return; + } + } + else if ((USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType & CONTROL_REQTYPE_RECIPIENT) == REQREC_ENDPOINT) + { + uint8_t EndpointAddress = (USB_ControlRequest.wIndex & 0xFF); + + if ((EndpointAddress != AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address) && + (EndpointAddress != AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Address)) + { + return; + } + } + + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case REQ_SetInterface: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + AudioInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceEnabled = ((USB_ControlRequest.wValue & 0xFF) != 0); + EVENT_Audio_Device_StreamStartStop(AudioInterfaceInfo); + } + + break; + case AUDIO_REQ_GetStatus: + if ((USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) || + (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_ENDPOINT))) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + case AUDIO_REQ_SetCurrent: + case AUDIO_REQ_SetMinimum: + case AUDIO_REQ_SetMaximum: + case AUDIO_REQ_SetResolution: + if ((USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType & CONTROL_REQTYPE_RECIPIENT) == REQREC_ENDPOINT) + { + uint8_t EndpointProperty = USB_ControlRequest.bRequest; + uint8_t EndpointAddress = (uint8_t)USB_ControlRequest.wIndex; + uint8_t EndpointControl = (USB_ControlRequest.wValue >> 8); + + if (CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetEndpointProperty(AudioInterfaceInfo, EndpointProperty, EndpointAddress, + EndpointControl, NULL, NULL)) + { + uint16_t ValueLength = USB_ControlRequest.wLength; + uint8_t Value[ValueLength]; + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE(Value, ValueLength); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetEndpointProperty(AudioInterfaceInfo, EndpointProperty, EndpointAddress, + EndpointControl, &ValueLength, Value); + } + } + else if ((USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType & CONTROL_REQTYPE_RECIPIENT) == REQREC_INTERFACE) + { + uint8_t Property = USB_ControlRequest.bRequest; + uint8_t Entity = (USB_ControlRequest.wIndex >> 8); + uint16_t Parameter = USB_ControlRequest.wValue; + + if (CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetInterfaceProperty(AudioInterfaceInfo, Property, Entity, + Parameter, NULL, NULL)) + { + uint16_t ValueLength = USB_ControlRequest.wLength; + uint8_t Value[ValueLength]; + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE(Value, ValueLength); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetInterfaceProperty(AudioInterfaceInfo, Property, Entity, + Parameter, &ValueLength, Value); + } + } + + break; + case AUDIO_REQ_GetCurrent: + case AUDIO_REQ_GetMinimum: + case AUDIO_REQ_GetMaximum: + case AUDIO_REQ_GetResolution: + if ((USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType & CONTROL_REQTYPE_RECIPIENT) == REQREC_ENDPOINT) + { + uint8_t EndpointProperty = USB_ControlRequest.bRequest; + uint8_t EndpointAddress = (uint8_t)USB_ControlRequest.wIndex; + uint8_t EndpointControl = (USB_ControlRequest.wValue >> 8); + uint16_t ValueLength = USB_ControlRequest.wLength; + uint8_t Value[ValueLength]; + + if (CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetEndpointProperty(AudioInterfaceInfo, EndpointProperty, EndpointAddress, + EndpointControl, &ValueLength, Value)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(Value, ValueLength); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + } + else if ((USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType & CONTROL_REQTYPE_RECIPIENT) == REQREC_INTERFACE) + { + uint8_t Property = USB_ControlRequest.bRequest; + uint8_t Entity = (USB_ControlRequest.wIndex >> 8); + uint16_t Parameter = USB_ControlRequest.wValue; + uint16_t ValueLength = USB_ControlRequest.wLength; + uint8_t Value[ValueLength]; + + if (CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetInterfaceProperty(AudioInterfaceInfo, Property, Entity, + Parameter, &ValueLength, Value)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(Value, ValueLength); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + } + + break; + } +} + +bool Audio_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) +{ + memset(&AudioInterfaceInfo->State, 0x00, sizeof(AudioInterfaceInfo->State)); + + AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Type = EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS; + AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Type = EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS; + + if (!(Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(&AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint, 1))) + return false; + + if (!(Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(&AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint, 1))) + return false; + + return true; +} + +void Audio_Device_Event_Stub(void) +{ + +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/AudioClassDevice.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/AudioClassDevice.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ca63511b20 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/AudioClassDevice.h @@ -0,0 +1,396 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Device mode driver for the library USB Audio 1.0 Class driver. + * + * Device mode driver for the library USB Audio 1.0 Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassAudio + * \defgroup Group_USBClassAudioDevice Audio 1.0 Class Device Mode Driver + * + * \section Sec_USBClassAudioDevice_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/AudioClassDevice.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassAudioDevice_ModDescription Module Description + * Device Mode USB Class driver framework interface, for the Audio 1.0 USB Class driver. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _AUDIO_CLASS_DEVICE_H_ +#define _AUDIO_CLASS_DEVICE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../USB.h" + #include "../Common/AudioClassCommon.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_AUDIO_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief Audio Class Device Mode Configuration and State Structure. + * + * Class state structure. An instance of this structure should be made for each Audio interface + * within the user application, and passed to each of the Audio class driver functions as the + * \c AudioInterfaceInfo parameter. This stores each Audio interface's configuration and state information. + */ + typedef struct + { + struct + { + uint8_t ControlInterfaceNumber; /**< Index of the Audio Control interface within the device this + * structure controls. + */ + uint8_t StreamingInterfaceNumber; /**< Index of the Audio Streaming interface within the device this + * structure controls. + */ + + USB_Endpoint_Table_t DataINEndpoint; /**< Data IN endpoint configuration table. */ + USB_Endpoint_Table_t DataOUTEndpoint; /**< Data OUT endpoint configuration table. */ + } Config; /**< Config data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>must</b> be set or the interface will fail to enumerate and operate correctly. + */ + struct + { + bool InterfaceEnabled; /**< Set and cleared by the class driver to indicate if the host has enabled the streaming endpoints + * of the Audio Streaming interface. + */ + } State; /**< State data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * are reset to their defaults when the interface is enumerated. + */ + } USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Configures the endpoints of a given Audio interface, ready for use. This should be linked to the library + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged() event so that the endpoints are configured when the configuration containing the + * given Audio interface is selected. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the endpoints were successfully configured, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool Audio_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Processes incoming control requests from the host, that are directed to the given Audio class interface. This should be + * linked to the library \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + */ + void Audio_Device_ProcessControlRequest(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Audio class driver callback for the setting and retrieval of streaming endpoint properties. This callback must be implemented + * in the user application to handle property manipulations on streaming audio endpoints. + * + * When the DataLength parameter is NULL, this callback should only indicate whether the specified operation is valid for + * the given endpoint index, and should return as fast as possible. When non-NULL, this value may be altered for GET operations + * to indicate the size of the retrieved data. + * + * \note The length of the retrieved data stored into the Data buffer on GET operations should not exceed the initial value + * of the \c DataLength parameter. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] EndpointProperty Property of the endpoint to get or set, a value from \ref Audio_ClassRequests_t. + * \param[in] EndpointAddress Address of the streaming endpoint whose property is being referenced. + * \param[in] EndpointControl Parameter of the endpoint to get or set, a value from \ref Audio_EndpointControls_t. + * \param[in,out] DataLength For SET operations, the length of the parameter data to set. For GET operations, the maximum + * length of the retrieved data. When NULL, the function should return whether the given property + * and parameter is valid for the requested endpoint without reading or modifying the Data buffer. + * \param[in,out] Data Pointer to a location where the parameter data is stored for SET operations, or where + * the retrieved data is to be stored for GET operations. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the property GET/SET was successful, \c false otherwise + */ + bool CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetEndpointProperty(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t EndpointProperty, + const uint8_t EndpointAddress, + const uint8_t EndpointControl, + uint16_t* const DataLength, + uint8_t* Data) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Audio class driver callback for the setting and retrieval of streaming interface properties. This callback must be implemented + * in the user application to handle property manipulations on streaming audio interfaces. + * + * When the DataLength parameter is NULL, this callback should only indicate whether the specified operation is valid for + * the given entity and should return as fast as possible. When non-NULL, this value may be altered for GET operations + * to indicate the size of the retrieved data. + * + * \note The length of the retrieved data stored into the Data buffer on GET operations should not exceed the initial value + * of the \c DataLength parameter. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] Property Property of the interface to get or set, a value from \ref Audio_ClassRequests_t. + * \param[in] EntityAddress Address of the audio entity whose property is being referenced. + * \param[in] Parameter Parameter of the entity to get or set, specific to each type of entity (see USB Audio specification). + * \param[in,out] DataLength For SET operations, the length of the parameter data to set. For GET operations, the maximum + * length of the retrieved data. When NULL, the function should return whether the given property + * and parameter is valid for the requested endpoint without reading or modifying the Data buffer. + * \param[in,out] Data Pointer to a location where the parameter data is stored for SET operations, or where + * the retrieved data is to be stored for GET operations. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the property GET/SET was successful, \c false otherwise + */ + bool CALLBACK_Audio_Device_GetSetInterfaceProperty(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t Property, + const uint8_t EntityAddress, + const uint16_t Parameter, + uint16_t* const DataLength, + uint8_t* Data) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Audio class driver event for an Audio Stream start/stop change. This event fires each time the device receives a stream enable or + * disable control request from the host, to start and stop the audio stream. The current state of the stream can be determined by the + * State.InterfaceEnabled value inside the Audio interface structure passed as a parameter. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + */ + void EVENT_Audio_Device_StreamStartStop(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo); + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** General management task for a given Audio class interface, required for the correct operation of the interface. This should + * be called frequently in the main program loop, before the master USB management task \ref USB_USBTask(). + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + */ + static inline void Audio_Device_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Audio_Device_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + { + (void)AudioInterfaceInfo; + } + + /** Determines if the given audio interface is ready for a sample to be read from it, and selects the streaming + * OUT endpoint ready for reading. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the given Audio interface has a sample to be read, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Audio_Device_IsSampleReceived(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Audio_Device_IsSampleReceived(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + { + if ((USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) || !(AudioInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceEnabled)) + return false; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Address); + return Endpoint_IsOUTReceived(); + } + + /** Determines if the given audio interface is ready to accept the next sample to be written to it, and selects + * the streaming IN endpoint ready for writing. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the given Audio interface is ready to accept the next sample, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Audio_Device_IsReadyForNextSample(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Audio_Device_IsReadyForNextSample(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + { + if ((USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) || !(AudioInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceEnabled)) + return false; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + return Endpoint_IsINReady(); + } + + /** Reads the next 8-bit audio sample from the current audio interface. + * + * \pre This should be preceded immediately by a call to the \ref Audio_Device_IsSampleReceived() function to ensure + * that the correct endpoint is selected and ready for data. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Signed 8-bit audio sample from the audio interface. + */ + static inline int8_t Audio_Device_ReadSample8(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline int8_t Audio_Device_ReadSample8(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + { + int8_t Sample; + + (void)AudioInterfaceInfo; + + Sample = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint())) + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + return Sample; + } + + /** Reads the next 16-bit audio sample from the current audio interface. + * + * \pre This should be preceded immediately by a call to the \ref Audio_Device_IsSampleReceived() function to ensure + * that the correct endpoint is selected and ready for data. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Signed 16-bit audio sample from the audio interface. + */ + static inline int16_t Audio_Device_ReadSample16(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline int16_t Audio_Device_ReadSample16(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + { + int16_t Sample; + + (void)AudioInterfaceInfo; + + Sample = (int16_t)Endpoint_Read_16_LE(); + + if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint())) + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + return Sample; + } + + /** Reads the next 24-bit audio sample from the current audio interface. + * + * \pre This should be preceded immediately by a call to the \ref Audio_Device_IsSampleReceived() function to ensure + * that the correct endpoint is selected and ready for data. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Signed 24-bit audio sample from the audio interface. + */ + static inline int32_t Audio_Device_ReadSample24(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline int32_t Audio_Device_ReadSample24(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + { + int32_t Sample; + + (void)AudioInterfaceInfo; + + Sample = (((uint32_t)Endpoint_Read_8() << 16) | Endpoint_Read_16_LE()); + + if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint())) + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + return Sample; + } + + /** Writes the next 8-bit audio sample to the current audio interface. + * + * \pre This should be preceded immediately by a call to the \ref Audio_Device_IsReadyForNextSample() function to + * ensure that the correct endpoint is selected and ready for data. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] Sample Signed 8-bit audio sample. + */ + static inline void Audio_Device_WriteSample8(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const int8_t Sample) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Audio_Device_WriteSample8(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const int8_t Sample) + { + Endpoint_Write_8(Sample); + + if (Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint() == AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Size) + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } + + /** Writes the next 16-bit audio sample to the current audio interface. + * + * \pre This should be preceded immediately by a call to the \ref Audio_Device_IsReadyForNextSample() function to + * ensure that the correct endpoint is selected and ready for data. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] Sample Signed 16-bit audio sample. + */ + static inline void Audio_Device_WriteSample16(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const int16_t Sample) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Audio_Device_WriteSample16(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const int16_t Sample) + { + Endpoint_Write_16_LE(Sample); + + if (Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint() == AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Size) + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } + + /** Writes the next 24-bit audio sample to the current audio interface. + * + * \pre This should be preceded immediately by a call to the \ref Audio_Device_IsReadyForNextSample() function to + * ensure that the correct endpoint is selected and ready for data. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] Sample Signed 24-bit audio sample. + */ + static inline void Audio_Device_WriteSample24(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const int32_t Sample) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Audio_Device_WriteSample24(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const int32_t Sample) + { + Endpoint_Write_16_LE(Sample); + Endpoint_Write_8(Sample >> 16); + + if (Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint() == AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Size) + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_AUDIO_DEVICE_C) + void Audio_Device_Event_Stub(void) ATTR_CONST; + + void EVENT_Audio_Device_StreamStartStop(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + ATTR_WEAK ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALIAS(Audio_Device_Event_Stub); + #endif + + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/CDCClassDevice.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/CDCClassDevice.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..867548c00b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/CDCClassDevice.c @@ -0,0 +1,362 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../../Core/USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_CDC_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_CDC_DEVICE_C +#include "CDCClassDevice.h" + +void CDC_Device_ProcessControlRequest(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + if (!(Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived())) + return; + + if (USB_ControlRequest.wIndex != CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.ControlInterfaceNumber) + return; + + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case CDC_REQ_GetLineEncoding: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())); + + Endpoint_Write_32_LE(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.BaudRateBPS); + Endpoint_Write_8(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.CharFormat); + Endpoint_Write_8(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.ParityType); + Endpoint_Write_8(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.DataBits); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + case CDC_REQ_SetLineEncoding: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + + CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.BaudRateBPS = Endpoint_Read_32_LE(); + CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.CharFormat = Endpoint_Read_8(); + CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.ParityType = Endpoint_Read_8(); + CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.DataBits = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + EVENT_CDC_Device_LineEncodingChanged(CDCInterfaceInfo); + } + + break; + case CDC_REQ_SetControlLineState: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + CDCInterfaceInfo->State.ControlLineStates.HostToDevice = USB_ControlRequest.wValue; + + EVENT_CDC_Device_ControLineStateChanged(CDCInterfaceInfo); + } + + break; + case CDC_REQ_SendBreak: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + EVENT_CDC_Device_BreakSent(CDCInterfaceInfo, (uint8_t)USB_ControlRequest.wValue); + } + + break; + } +} + +bool CDC_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + memset(&CDCInterfaceInfo->State, 0x00, sizeof(CDCInterfaceInfo->State)); + + CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.NotificationEndpoint.Type = EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT; + + if (!(Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(&CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint, 1))) + return false; + + if (!(Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(&CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint, 1))) + return false; + + if (!(Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(&CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.NotificationEndpoint, 1))) + return false; + + return true; +} + +void CDC_Device_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) || !(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.BaudRateBPS)) + return; + + #if !defined(NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH) + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + + if (Endpoint_IsINReady()) + CDC_Device_Flush(CDCInterfaceInfo); + #endif +} + +uint8_t CDC_Device_SendString(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const char* const String) +{ + if ((USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) || !(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.BaudRateBPS)) + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + return Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(String, strlen(String), NULL); +} + +uint8_t CDC_Device_SendString_P(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const char* const String) +{ + if ((USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) || !(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.BaudRateBPS)) + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + return Endpoint_Write_PStream_LE(String, strlen_P(String), NULL); +} + +uint8_t CDC_Device_SendData(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) +{ + if ((USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) || !(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.BaudRateBPS)) + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + return Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(Buffer, Length, NULL); +} + +uint8_t CDC_Device_SendData_P(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) +{ + if ((USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) || !(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.BaudRateBPS)) + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + return Endpoint_Write_PStream_LE(Buffer, Length, NULL); +} + +uint8_t CDC_Device_SendByte(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t Data) +{ + if ((USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) || !(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.BaudRateBPS)) + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) != ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + } + + Endpoint_Write_8(Data); + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError; +} + +uint8_t CDC_Device_Flush(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) || !(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.BaudRateBPS)) + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + + if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint())) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError; + + bool BankFull = !(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed()); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + if (BankFull) + { + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) != ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } + + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError; +} + +uint16_t CDC_Device_BytesReceived(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) || !(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.BaudRateBPS)) + return 0; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Address); + + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + { + if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint())) + { + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + return 0; + } + else + { + return Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint(); + } + } + else + { + return 0; + } +} + +int16_t CDC_Device_ReceiveByte(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) || !(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.BaudRateBPS)) + return -1; + + int16_t ReceivedByte = -1; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Address); + + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + { + if (Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint()) + ReceivedByte = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint())) + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + + return ReceivedByte; +} + +void CDC_Device_SendControlLineStateChange(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) || !(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.BaudRateBPS)) + return; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.NotificationEndpoint.Address); + + USB_Request_Header_t Notification = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = CDC_NOTIF_SerialState, + .wValue = CPU_TO_LE16(0), + .wIndex = CPU_TO_LE16(0), + .wLength = CPU_TO_LE16(sizeof(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.ControlLineStates.DeviceToHost)), + }; + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&Notification, sizeof(USB_Request_Header_t), NULL); + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&CDCInterfaceInfo->State.ControlLineStates.DeviceToHost, + sizeof(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.ControlLineStates.DeviceToHost), + NULL); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +#if defined(FDEV_SETUP_STREAM) +void CDC_Device_CreateStream(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + FILE* const Stream) +{ + *Stream = (FILE)FDEV_SETUP_STREAM(CDC_Device_putchar, CDC_Device_getchar, _FDEV_SETUP_RW); + fdev_set_udata(Stream, CDCInterfaceInfo); +} + +void CDC_Device_CreateBlockingStream(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + FILE* const Stream) +{ + *Stream = (FILE)FDEV_SETUP_STREAM(CDC_Device_putchar, CDC_Device_getchar_Blocking, _FDEV_SETUP_RW); + fdev_set_udata(Stream, CDCInterfaceInfo); +} + +static int CDC_Device_putchar(char c, + FILE* Stream) +{ + return CDC_Device_SendByte((USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t*)fdev_get_udata(Stream), c) ? _FDEV_ERR : 0; +} + +static int CDC_Device_getchar(FILE* Stream) +{ + int16_t ReceivedByte = CDC_Device_ReceiveByte((USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t*)fdev_get_udata(Stream)); + + if (ReceivedByte < 0) + return _FDEV_EOF; + + return ReceivedByte; +} + +static int CDC_Device_getchar_Blocking(FILE* Stream) +{ + int16_t ReceivedByte; + + while ((ReceivedByte = CDC_Device_ReceiveByte((USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t*)fdev_get_udata(Stream))) < 0) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return _FDEV_EOF; + + CDC_Device_USBTask((USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t*)fdev_get_udata(Stream)); + USB_USBTask(); + } + + return ReceivedByte; +} +#endif + +void CDC_Device_Event_Stub(void) +{ + +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/CDCClassDevice.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/CDCClassDevice.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9d5c4e5a0a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/CDCClassDevice.h @@ -0,0 +1,386 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Device mode driver for the library USB CDC Class driver. + * + * Device mode driver for the library USB CDC Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassCDC + * \defgroup Group_USBClassCDCDevice CDC Class Device Mode Driver + * + * \section Sec_USBClassCDCDevice_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/CDCClassDevice.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassCDCDevice_ModDescription Module Description + * Device Mode USB Class driver framework interface, for the CDC USB Class driver. + * + * \note There are several major drawbacks to the CDC-ACM standard USB class, however + * it is very standardized and thus usually available as a built-in driver on + * most platforms, and so is a better choice than a proprietary serial class. + * + * One major issue with CDC-ACM is that it requires two Interface descriptors, + * which will upset most hosts when part of a multi-function "Composite" USB + * device. This is because each interface will be loaded into a separate driver + * instance, causing the two interfaces be become unlinked. To prevent this, you + * should use the "Interface Association Descriptor" addendum to the USB 2.0 standard + * which is available on most OSes when creating Composite devices. + * + * Another major oversight is that there is no mechanism for the host to notify the + * device that there is a data sink on the host side ready to accept data. This + * means that the device may try to send data while the host isn't listening, causing + * lengthy blocking timeouts in the transmission routines. It is thus highly recommended + * that the virtual serial line DTR (Data Terminal Ready) signal be used where possible + * to determine if a host application is ready for data. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _CDC_CLASS_DEVICE_H_ +#define _CDC_CLASS_DEVICE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../USB.h" + #include "../Common/CDCClassCommon.h" + + #include <stdio.h> + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_CDC_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief CDC Class Device Mode Configuration and State Structure. + * + * Class state structure. An instance of this structure should be made for each CDC interface + * within the user application, and passed to each of the CDC class driver functions as the + * CDCInterfaceInfo parameter. This stores each CDC interface's configuration and state information. + */ + typedef struct + { + struct + { + uint8_t ControlInterfaceNumber; /**< Interface number of the CDC control interface within the device. */ + + USB_Endpoint_Table_t DataINEndpoint; /**< Data IN endpoint configuration table. */ + USB_Endpoint_Table_t DataOUTEndpoint; /**< Data OUT endpoint configuration table. */ + USB_Endpoint_Table_t NotificationEndpoint; /**< Notification IN Endpoint configuration table. */ + } Config; /**< Config data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>must</b> be set or the interface will fail to enumerate and operate correctly. + */ + struct + { + struct + { + uint16_t HostToDevice; /**< Control line states from the host to device, as a set of \c CDC_CONTROL_LINE_OUT_* + * masks. This value is updated each time \ref CDC_Device_USBTask() is called. + */ + uint16_t DeviceToHost; /**< Control line states from the device to host, as a set of \c CDC_CONTROL_LINE_IN_* + * masks - to notify the host of changes to these values, call the + * \ref CDC_Device_SendControlLineStateChange() function. + */ + } ControlLineStates; /**< Current states of the virtual serial port's control lines between the device and host. */ + + CDC_LineEncoding_t LineEncoding; /**< Line encoding used in the virtual serial port, for the device's information. + * This is generally only used if the virtual serial port data is to be + * reconstructed on a physical UART. + */ + } State; /**< State data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * are reset to their defaults when the interface is enumerated. + */ + } USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Configures the endpoints of a given CDC interface, ready for use. This should be linked to the library + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged() event so that the endpoints are configured when the configuration containing + * the given CDC interface is selected. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the endpoints were successfully configured, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool CDC_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Processes incoming control requests from the host, that are directed to the given CDC class interface. This should be + * linked to the library \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class configuration and state. + */ + void CDC_Device_ProcessControlRequest(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** General management task for a given CDC class interface, required for the correct operation of the interface. This should + * be called frequently in the main program loop, before the master USB management task \ref USB_USBTask(). + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class configuration and state. + */ + void CDC_Device_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** CDC class driver event for a line encoding change on a CDC interface. This event fires each time the host requests a + * line encoding change (containing the serial parity, baud and other configuration information) and may be hooked in the + * user program by declaring a handler function with the same name and parameters listed here. The new line encoding + * settings are available in the \c LineEncoding structure inside the CDC interface structure passed as a parameter. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class configuration and state. + */ + void EVENT_CDC_Device_LineEncodingChanged(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** CDC class driver event for a control line state change on a CDC interface. This event fires each time the host requests a + * control line state change (containing the virtual serial control line states, such as DTR) and may be hooked in the + * user program by declaring a handler function with the same name and parameters listed here. The new control line states + * are available in the \c ControlLineStates.HostToDevice value inside the CDC interface structure passed as a parameter, set as + * a mask of \c CDC_CONTROL_LINE_OUT_* masks. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class configuration and state. + */ + void EVENT_CDC_Device_ControLineStateChanged(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** CDC class driver event for a send break request sent to the device from the host. This is generally used to separate + * data or to indicate a special condition to the receiving device. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] Duration Duration of the break that has been sent by the host, in milliseconds. + */ + void EVENT_CDC_Device_BreakSent(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t Duration) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sends a given data buffer to the attached USB host, if connected. If a host is not connected when the function is + * called, the string is discarded. Bytes will be queued for transmission to the host until either the endpoint bank + * becomes full, or the \ref CDC_Device_Flush() function is called to flush the pending data to the host. This allows + * for multiple bytes to be packed into a single endpoint packet, increasing data throughput. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to a buffer containing the data to send to the device. + * \param[in] Length Length of the data to send to the host. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t CDC_Device_SendData(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Sends a given data buffer from PROGMEM space to the attached USB host, if connected. If a host is not connected when the + * function is called, the string is discarded. Bytes will be queued for transmission to the host until either the endpoint + * bank becomes full, or the \ref CDC_Device_Flush() function is called to flush the pending data to the host. This allows + * for multiple bytes to be packed into a single endpoint packet, increasing data throughput. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to a buffer containing the data to send to the device. + * \param[in] Length Length of the data to send to the host. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t CDC_Device_SendData_P(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Sends a given null terminated string to the attached USB host, if connected. If a host is not connected when + * the function is called, the string is discarded. Bytes will be queued for transmission to the host until either + * the endpoint bank becomes full, or the \ref CDC_Device_Flush() function is called to flush the pending data to + * the host. This allows for multiple bytes to be packed into a single endpoint packet, increasing data throughput. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] String Pointer to the null terminated string to send to the host. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t CDC_Device_SendString(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const char* const String) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Sends a given null terminated string from PROGMEM space to the attached USB host, if connected. If a host is not connected + * when the function is called, the string is discarded. Bytes will be queued for transmission to the host until either + * the endpoint bank becomes full, or the \ref CDC_Device_Flush() function is called to flush the pending data to + * the host. This allows for multiple bytes to be packed into a single endpoint packet, increasing data throughput. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] String Pointer to the null terminated string to send to the host. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t CDC_Device_SendString_P(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const char* const String) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Sends a given byte to the attached USB host, if connected. If a host is not connected when the function is called, the + * byte is discarded. Bytes will be queued for transmission to the host until either the endpoint bank becomes full, or the + * \ref CDC_Device_Flush() function is called to flush the pending data to the host. This allows for multiple bytes to be + * packed into a single endpoint packet, increasing data throughput. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] Data Byte of data to send to the host. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t CDC_Device_SendByte(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t Data) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Determines the number of bytes received by the CDC interface from the host, waiting to be read. This indicates the number + * of bytes in the OUT endpoint bank only, and thus the number of calls to \ref CDC_Device_ReceiveByte() which are guaranteed to + * succeed immediately. If multiple bytes are to be received, they should be buffered by the user application, as the endpoint + * bank will not be released back to the USB controller until all bytes are read. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Total number of buffered bytes received from the host. + */ + uint16_t CDC_Device_BytesReceived(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads a byte of data from the host. If no data is waiting to be read of if a USB host is not connected, the function + * returns a negative value. The \ref CDC_Device_BytesReceived() function may be queried in advance to determine how many + * bytes are currently buffered in the CDC interface's data receive endpoint bank, and thus how many repeated calls to this + * function which are guaranteed to succeed. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Next received byte from the host, or a negative value if no data received. + */ + int16_t CDC_Device_ReceiveByte(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Flushes any data waiting to be sent, ensuring that the send buffer is cleared. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class configuration and state. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t CDC_Device_Flush(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sends a Serial Control Line State Change notification to the host. This should be called when the virtual serial + * control lines (DCD, DSR, etc.) have changed states, or to give BREAK notifications to the host. Line states persist + * until they are cleared via a second notification. This should be called each time the CDC class driver's + * \c ControlLineStates.DeviceToHost value is updated to push the new states to the USB host. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class configuration and state. + */ + void CDC_Device_SendControlLineStateChange(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + #if defined(FDEV_SETUP_STREAM) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Creates a standard character stream for the given CDC Device instance so that it can be used with all the regular + * functions in the standard <stdio.h> library that accept a \c FILE stream as a destination (e.g. \c fprintf()). The created + * stream is bidirectional and can be used for both input and output functions. + * + * Reading data from this stream is non-blocking, i.e. in most instances, complete strings cannot be read in by a single + * fetch, as the endpoint will not be ready at some point in the transmission, aborting the transfer. However, this may + * be used when the read data is processed byte-per-bye (via \c getc()) or when the user application will implement its own + * line buffering. + * + * \note The created stream can be given as \c stdout if desired to direct the standard output from all \c <stdio.h> functions + * to the given CDC interface. + * \n\n + * + * \note This function is not available on all microcontroller architectures. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class configuration and state. + * \param[in,out] Stream Pointer to a FILE structure where the created stream should be placed. + */ + void CDC_Device_CreateStream(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + FILE* const Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Identical to \ref CDC_Device_CreateStream(), except that reads are blocking until the calling stream function terminates + * the transfer. While blocking, the USB and CDC service tasks are called repeatedly to maintain USB communications. + * + * \note This function is not available on all microcontroller architectures. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class configuration and state. + * \param[in,out] Stream Pointer to a FILE structure where the created stream should be placed. + */ + void CDC_Device_CreateBlockingStream(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + FILE* const Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_CDC_DEVICE_C) + #if defined(FDEV_SETUP_STREAM) + static int CDC_Device_putchar(char c, + FILE* Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + static int CDC_Device_getchar(FILE* Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static int CDC_Device_getchar_Blocking(FILE* Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + #endif + + void CDC_Device_Event_Stub(void) ATTR_CONST; + + void EVENT_CDC_Device_LineEncodingChanged(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) + ATTR_WEAK ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALIAS(CDC_Device_Event_Stub); + void EVENT_CDC_Device_ControLineStateChanged(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) + ATTR_WEAK ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALIAS(CDC_Device_Event_Stub); + void EVENT_CDC_Device_BreakSent(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t Duration) ATTR_WEAK ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) + ATTR_ALIAS(CDC_Device_Event_Stub); + #endif + + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/HIDClassDevice.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/HIDClassDevice.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a8a6e8b50e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/HIDClassDevice.c @@ -0,0 +1,211 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../../Core/USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_HID_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_HID_DEVICE_C +#include "HIDClassDevice.h" + +void HID_Device_ProcessControlRequest(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo) +{ + if (!(Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived())) + return; + + if (USB_ControlRequest.wIndex != HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.InterfaceNumber) + return; + + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case HID_REQ_GetReport: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + uint16_t ReportSize = 0; + uint8_t ReportID = (USB_ControlRequest.wValue & 0xFF); + uint8_t ReportType = (USB_ControlRequest.wValue >> 8) - 1; + uint8_t ReportData[HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.PrevReportINBufferSize]; + + memset(ReportData, 0, sizeof(ReportData)); + + CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(HIDInterfaceInfo, &ReportID, ReportType, ReportData, &ReportSize); + + if (HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.PrevReportINBuffer != NULL) + { + memcpy(HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.PrevReportINBuffer, ReportData, + HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.PrevReportINBufferSize); + } + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP); + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + if (ReportID) + Endpoint_Write_8(ReportID); + + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(ReportData, ReportSize); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + + break; + case HID_REQ_SetReport: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + uint16_t ReportSize = USB_ControlRequest.wLength; + uint8_t ReportID = (USB_ControlRequest.wValue & 0xFF); + uint8_t ReportType = (USB_ControlRequest.wValue >> 8) - 1; + uint8_t ReportData[ReportSize]; + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE(ReportData, ReportSize); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(HIDInterfaceInfo, ReportID, ReportType, + &ReportData[ReportID ? 1 : 0], ReportSize - (ReportID ? 1 : 0)); + } + + break; + case HID_REQ_GetProtocol: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())); + Endpoint_Write_8(HIDInterfaceInfo->State.UsingReportProtocol); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + case HID_REQ_SetProtocol: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + HIDInterfaceInfo->State.UsingReportProtocol = ((USB_ControlRequest.wValue & 0xFF) != 0x00); + } + + break; + case HID_REQ_SetIdle: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + HIDInterfaceInfo->State.IdleCount = ((USB_ControlRequest.wValue & 0xFF00) >> 6); + } + + break; + case HID_REQ_GetIdle: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())); + Endpoint_Write_8(HIDInterfaceInfo->State.IdleCount >> 2); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + } +} + +bool HID_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo) +{ + memset(&HIDInterfaceInfo->State, 0x00, sizeof(HIDInterfaceInfo->State)); + HIDInterfaceInfo->State.UsingReportProtocol = true; + HIDInterfaceInfo->State.IdleCount = 500; + + HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.ReportINEndpoint.Type = EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT; + + if (!(Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(&HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.ReportINEndpoint, 1))) + return false; + + return true; +} + +void HID_Device_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo) +{ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + if (HIDInterfaceInfo->State.PrevFrameNum == USB_Device_GetFrameNumber()) + { + #if defined(USB_DEVICE_OPT_LOWSPEED) + if (!(USB_Options & USB_DEVICE_OPT_LOWSPEED)) + return; + #else + return; + #endif + } + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.ReportINEndpoint.Address); + + if (Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed()) + { + uint8_t ReportINData[HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.PrevReportINBufferSize]; + uint8_t ReportID = 0; + uint16_t ReportINSize = 0; + + memset(ReportINData, 0, sizeof(ReportINData)); + + bool ForceSend = CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(HIDInterfaceInfo, &ReportID, HID_REPORT_ITEM_In, + ReportINData, &ReportINSize); + bool StatesChanged = false; + bool IdlePeriodElapsed = (HIDInterfaceInfo->State.IdleCount && !(HIDInterfaceInfo->State.IdleMSRemaining)); + + if (HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.PrevReportINBuffer != NULL) + { + StatesChanged = (memcmp(ReportINData, HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.PrevReportINBuffer, ReportINSize) != 0); + memcpy(HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.PrevReportINBuffer, ReportINData, HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.PrevReportINBufferSize); + } + + if (ReportINSize && (ForceSend || StatesChanged || IdlePeriodElapsed)) + { + HIDInterfaceInfo->State.IdleMSRemaining = HIDInterfaceInfo->State.IdleCount; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.ReportINEndpoint.Address); + + if (ReportID) + Endpoint_Write_8(ReportID); + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(ReportINData, ReportINSize, NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } + + HIDInterfaceInfo->State.PrevFrameNum = USB_Device_GetFrameNumber(); + } +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/HIDClassDevice.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/HIDClassDevice.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ae628c87d4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/HIDClassDevice.h @@ -0,0 +1,210 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Device mode driver for the library USB HID Class driver. + * + * Device mode driver for the library USB HID Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassHID + * \defgroup Group_USBClassHIDDevice HID Class Device Mode Driver + * + * \section Sec_USBClassHIDDevice_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/HIDClassDevice.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassHIDDevice_ModDescription Module Description + * Device Mode USB Class driver framework interface, for the HID USB Class driver. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _HID_CLASS_DEVICE_H_ +#define _HID_CLASS_DEVICE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../USB.h" + #include "../Common/HIDClassCommon.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_HID_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief HID Class Device Mode Configuration and State Structure. + * + * Class state structure. An instance of this structure should be made for each HID interface + * within the user application, and passed to each of the HID class driver functions as the + * \c HIDInterfaceInfo parameter. This stores each HID interface's configuration and state information. + * + * \note Due to technical limitations, the HID device class driver does not utilize a separate OUT + * endpoint for host->device communications. Instead, the host->device data (if any) is sent to + * the device via the control endpoint. + */ + typedef struct + { + struct + { + uint8_t InterfaceNumber; /**< Interface number of the HID interface within the device. */ + + USB_Endpoint_Table_t ReportINEndpoint; /**< Data IN HID report endpoint configuration table. */ + + void* PrevReportINBuffer; /**< Pointer to a buffer where the previously created HID input report can be + * stored by the driver, for comparison purposes to detect report changes that + * must be sent immediately to the host. This should point to a buffer big enough + * to hold the largest HID input report sent from the HID interface. If this is set + * to \c NULL, it is up to the user to force transfers when needed in the + * \ref CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport() callback function. + * + * \note Due to the single buffer, the internal driver can only correctly compare + * subsequent reports with identical report IDs. In multiple report devices, + * this buffer should be set to \c NULL and the decision to send reports made + * by the user application instead. + */ + uint8_t PrevReportINBufferSize; /**< Size in bytes of the given input report buffer. This is used to create a + * second buffer of the same size within the driver so that subsequent reports + * can be compared. If the user app is to determine when reports are to be sent + * exclusively (i.e. \c PrevReportINBuffer is \c NULL) this value must still be + * set to the size of the largest report the device can issue to the host. + */ + } Config; /**< Config data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>must</b> be set or the interface will fail to enumerate and operate correctly. + */ + struct + { + bool UsingReportProtocol; /**< Indicates if the HID interface is set to Boot or Report protocol mode. */ + uint16_t PrevFrameNum; /**< Frame number of the previous HID report packet opportunity. */ + uint16_t IdleCount; /**< Report idle period, in milliseconds, set by the host. */ + uint16_t IdleMSRemaining; /**< Total number of milliseconds remaining before the idle period elapsed - this + * should be decremented by the user application if non-zero each millisecond. */ + } State; /**< State data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * are reset to their defaults when the interface is enumerated. + */ + } USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Configures the endpoints of a given HID interface, ready for use. This should be linked to the library + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged() event so that the endpoints are configured when the configuration + * containing the given HID interface is selected. + * + * \param[in,out] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a HID Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the endpoints were successfully configured, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool HID_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Processes incoming control requests from the host, that are directed to the given HID class interface. This should be + * linked to the library \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event. + * + * \param[in,out] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a HID Class configuration and state. + */ + void HID_Device_ProcessControlRequest(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** General management task for a given HID class interface, required for the correct operation of the interface. This should + * be called frequently in the main program loop, before the master USB management task \ref USB_USBTask(). + * + * \param[in,out] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a HID Class configuration and state. + */ + void HID_Device_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** HID class driver callback for the user creation of a HID IN report. This callback may fire in response to either + * HID class control requests from the host, or by the normal HID endpoint polling procedure. Inside this callback the + * user is responsible for the creation of the next HID input report to be sent to the host. + * + * \param[in,out] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a HID Class configuration and state. + * \param[in,out] ReportID If preset to a non-zero value, this is the report ID being requested by the host. If zero, + * this should be set to the report ID of the generated HID input report (if any). If multiple + * reports are not sent via the given HID interface, this parameter should be ignored. + * \param[in] ReportType Type of HID report to generate, either \ref HID_REPORT_ITEM_In or \ref HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature. + * \param[out] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the generated HID report should be stored. + * \param[out] ReportSize Number of bytes in the generated input report, or zero if no report is to be sent. + * + * \return Boolean \c true to force the sending of the report even if it is identical to the previous report and still within + * the idle period (useful for devices which report relative movement), \c false otherwise. + */ + bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(4) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(5); + + /** HID class driver callback for the user processing of a received HID OUT report. This callback may fire in response to + * either HID class control requests from the host, or by the normal HID endpoint polling procedure. Inside this callback + * the user is responsible for the processing of the received HID output report from the host. + * + * \param[in,out] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a HID Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] ReportID Report ID of the received output report. If multiple reports are not received via the given HID + * interface, this parameter should be ignored. + * \param[in] ReportType Type of received HID report, either \ref HID_REPORT_ITEM_Out or \ref HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature. + * \param[in] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the received HID report is stored. + * \param[in] ReportSize Size in bytes of the received report from the host. + */ + void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(4); + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Indicates that a millisecond of idle time has elapsed on the given HID interface, and the interface's idle count should be + * decremented. This should be called once per millisecond so that hardware key-repeats function correctly. It is recommended + * that this be called by the \ref EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame() event, once SOF events have been enabled via + * \ref USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(). + * + * \param[in,out] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a HID Class configuration and state. + */ + static inline void HID_Device_MillisecondElapsed(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void HID_Device_MillisecondElapsed(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo) + { + if (HIDInterfaceInfo->State.IdleMSRemaining) + HIDInterfaceInfo->State.IdleMSRemaining--; + } + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MIDIClassDevice.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MIDIClassDevice.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a35c4082bc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MIDIClassDevice.c @@ -0,0 +1,131 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../../Core/USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_MIDI_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_MIDI_DEVICE_C +#include "MIDIClassDevice.h" + +bool MIDI_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Device_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo) +{ + memset(&MIDIInterfaceInfo->State, 0x00, sizeof(MIDIInterfaceInfo->State)); + + MIDIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + MIDIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + + if (!(Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(&MIDIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint, 1))) + return false; + + if (!(Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(&MIDIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint, 1))) + return false; + + return true; +} + +void MIDI_Device_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Device_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo) +{ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + #if !defined(NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH) + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MIDIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + + if (Endpoint_IsINReady()) + MIDI_Device_Flush(MIDIInterfaceInfo); + #endif +} + +uint8_t MIDI_Device_SendEventPacket(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Device_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo, + const MIDI_EventPacket_t* const Event) +{ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MIDIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(Event, sizeof(MIDI_EventPacket_t), NULL)) != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +uint8_t MIDI_Device_Flush(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Device_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo) +{ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MIDIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + + if (Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint()) + { + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) != ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + } + + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError; +} + +bool MIDI_Device_ReceiveEventPacket(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Device_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo, + MIDI_EventPacket_t* const Event) +{ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return false; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MIDIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Address); + + if (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) + return false; + + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + return false; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(Event, sizeof(MIDI_EventPacket_t), NULL); + + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + return true; +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MIDIClassDevice.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MIDIClassDevice.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ee2efd7c18 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MIDIClassDevice.h @@ -0,0 +1,175 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Device mode driver for the library USB MIDI Class driver. + * + * Device mode driver for the library USB MIDI Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassMIDI + * \defgroup Group_USBClassMIDIDevice MIDI Class Device Mode Driver + * + * \section Sec_USBClassMIDIDevice_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MIDIClassDevice.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassMIDIDevice_ModDescription Module Description + * Device Mode USB Class driver framework interface, for the MIDI USB Class driver. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _MIDI_CLASS_DEVICE_H_ +#define _MIDI_CLASS_DEVICE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../USB.h" + #include "../Common/MIDIClassCommon.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_MIDI_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Type Define: */ + /** \brief MIDI Class Device Mode Configuration and State Structure. + * + * Class state structure. An instance of this structure should be made for each MIDI interface + * within the user application, and passed to each of the MIDI class driver functions as the + * \c MIDIInterfaceInfo parameter. This stores each MIDI interface's configuration and state information. + */ + typedef struct + { + struct + { + uint8_t StreamingInterfaceNumber; /**< Index of the Audio Streaming interface within the device this structure controls. */ + + USB_Endpoint_Table_t DataINEndpoint; /**< Data IN endpoint configuration table. */ + USB_Endpoint_Table_t DataOUTEndpoint; /**< Data OUT endpoint configuration table. */ + } Config; /**< Config data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>must</b> be set or the interface will fail to enumerate and operate correctly. + */ + + struct + { + uint8_t RESERVED; // No state information for this class + } State; /**< State data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * are reset to their defaults when the interface is enumerated. + */ + } USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Device_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Configures the endpoints of a given MIDI interface, ready for use. This should be linked to the library + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged() event so that the endpoints are configured when the configuration + * containing the given MIDI interface is selected. + * + * \param[in,out] MIDIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a MIDI Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the endpoints were successfully configured, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool MIDI_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Device_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** General management task for a given MIDI class interface, required for the correct operation of the interface. This should + * be called frequently in the main program loop, before the master USB management task \ref USB_USBTask(). + * + * \param[in,out] MIDIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a MIDI Class configuration and state. + */ + void MIDI_Device_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Device_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sends a MIDI event packet to the host. If no host is connected, the event packet is discarded. Events are queued into the + * endpoint bank until either the endpoint bank is full, or \ref MIDI_Device_Flush() is called. This allows for multiple + * MIDI events to be packed into a single endpoint packet, increasing data throughput. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] MIDIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a MIDI Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] Event Pointer to a populated \ref MIDI_EventPacket_t structure containing the MIDI event to send. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t MIDI_Device_SendEventPacket(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Device_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo, + const MIDI_EventPacket_t* const Event) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + + /** Flushes the MIDI send buffer, sending any queued MIDI events to the host. This should be called to override the + * \ref MIDI_Device_SendEventPacket() function's packing behavior, to flush queued events. + * + * \param[in,out] MIDIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a MIDI Class configuration and state. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t MIDI_Device_Flush(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Device_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Receives a MIDI event packet from the host. Events are unpacked from the endpoint, thus if the endpoint bank contains + * multiple MIDI events from the host in the one packet, multiple calls to this function will return each individual event. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] MIDIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a MIDI Class configuration and state. + * \param[out] Event Pointer to a USB_MIDI_EventPacket_t structure where the received MIDI event is to be placed. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if a MIDI event packet was received, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool MIDI_Device_ReceiveEventPacket(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Device_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo, + MIDI_EventPacket_t* const Event) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Processes incoming control requests from the host, that are directed to the given MIDI class interface. This should be + * linked to the library \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event. + * + * \param[in,out] MIDIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a MIDI Class configuration and state. + */ + static inline void MIDI_Device_ProcessControlRequest(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Device_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void MIDI_Device_ProcessControlRequest(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Device_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo) + { + (void)MIDIInterfaceInfo; + } + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MassStorageClassDevice.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MassStorageClassDevice.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1ea30f7cbc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MassStorageClassDevice.c @@ -0,0 +1,215 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../../Core/USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_MS_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_MASSSTORAGE_DEVICE_C +#include "MassStorageClassDevice.h" + +void MS_Device_ProcessControlRequest(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + if (!(Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived())) + return; + + if (USB_ControlRequest.wIndex != MSInterfaceInfo->Config.InterfaceNumber) + return; + + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case MS_REQ_MassStorageReset: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset = true; + } + + break; + case MS_REQ_GetMaxLUN: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())); + Endpoint_Write_8(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.TotalLUNs - 1); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + } +} + +bool MS_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + memset(&MSInterfaceInfo->State, 0x00, sizeof(MSInterfaceInfo->State)); + + MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + + if (!(Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(&MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint, 1))) + return false; + + if (!(Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(&MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint, 1))) + return false; + + return true; +} + +void MS_Device_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Address); + + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + { + if (MS_Device_ReadInCommandBlock(MSInterfaceInfo)) + { + if (MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.Flags & MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_IN) + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + + bool SCSICommandResult = CALLBACK_MS_Device_SCSICommandReceived(MSInterfaceInfo); + + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandStatus.Status = (SCSICommandResult) ? MS_SCSI_COMMAND_Pass : MS_SCSI_COMMAND_Fail; + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandStatus.Signature = CPU_TO_LE32(MS_CSW_SIGNATURE); + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandStatus.Tag = MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.Tag; + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandStatus.DataTransferResidue = MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength; + + if (!(SCSICommandResult) && (le32_to_cpu(MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandStatus.DataTransferResidue))) + Endpoint_StallTransaction(); + + MS_Device_ReturnCommandStatus(MSInterfaceInfo); + } + } + + if (MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset) + { + Endpoint_ResetEndpoint(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Address); + Endpoint_ResetEndpoint(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Address); + Endpoint_ClearStall(); + Endpoint_ResetDataToggle(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + Endpoint_ClearStall(); + Endpoint_ResetDataToggle(); + + MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset = false; + } +} + +static bool MS_Device_ReadInCommandBlock(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint16_t BytesProcessed; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Address); + + BytesProcessed = 0; + while (Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock, + (sizeof(MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t) - 16), &BytesProcessed) == + ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + { + if (MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset) + return false; + } + + if ((MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.Signature != CPU_TO_LE32(MS_CBW_SIGNATURE)) || + (MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.LUN >= MSInterfaceInfo->Config.TotalLUNs) || + (MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.Flags & 0x1F) || + (MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandLength == 0) || + (MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandLength > 16)) + { + Endpoint_StallTransaction(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + Endpoint_StallTransaction(); + + return false; + } + + BytesProcessed = 0; + while (Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData, + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandLength, &BytesProcessed) == + ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + { + if (MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset) + return false; + } + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + return true; +} + +static void MS_Device_ReturnCommandStatus(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Address); + + while (Endpoint_IsStalled()) + { + #if !defined(INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT) + USB_USBTask(); + #endif + + if (MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset) + return; + } + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + + while (Endpoint_IsStalled()) + { + #if !defined(INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT) + USB_USBTask(); + #endif + + if (MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset) + return; + } + + uint16_t BytesProcessed = 0; + while (Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandStatus, + sizeof(MS_CommandStatusWrapper_t), &BytesProcessed) == + ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + { + if (MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset) + return; + } + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MassStorageClassDevice.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MassStorageClassDevice.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..12b54f8dfb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MassStorageClassDevice.h @@ -0,0 +1,161 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Device mode driver for the library USB Mass Storage Class driver. + * + * Device mode driver for the library USB Mass Storage Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassMS + * \defgroup Group_USBClassMSDevice Mass Storage Class Device Mode Driver + * + * \section Sec_USBClassMSDevice_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MassStorageClassDevice.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassMSDevice_ModDescription Module Description + * Device Mode USB Class driver framework interface, for the Mass Storage USB Class driver. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _MS_CLASS_DEVICE_H_ +#define _MS_CLASS_DEVICE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../USB.h" + #include "../Common/MassStorageClassCommon.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_MS_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief Mass Storage Class Device Mode Configuration and State Structure. + * + * Class state structure. An instance of this structure should be made for each Mass Storage interface + * within the user application, and passed to each of the Mass Storage class driver functions as the + * \c MSInterfaceInfo parameter. This stores each Mass Storage interface's configuration and state information. + */ + typedef struct + { + struct + { + uint8_t InterfaceNumber; /**< Interface number of the Mass Storage interface within the device. */ + + USB_Endpoint_Table_t DataINEndpoint; /**< Data IN endpoint configuration table. */ + USB_Endpoint_Table_t DataOUTEndpoint; /**< Data OUT endpoint configuration table. */ + + uint8_t TotalLUNs; /**< Total number of logical drives in the Mass Storage interface. */ + } Config; /**< Config data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>must</b> be set or the interface will fail to enumerate and operate correctly. + */ + struct + { + MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t CommandBlock; /**< Mass Storage class command block structure, stores the received SCSI + * command from the host which is to be processed. + */ + MS_CommandStatusWrapper_t CommandStatus; /**< Mass Storage class command status structure, set elements to indicate + * the issued command's success or failure to the host. + */ + volatile bool IsMassStoreReset; /**< Flag indicating that the host has requested that the Mass Storage interface be reset + * and that all current Mass Storage operations should immediately abort. + */ + } State; /**< State data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * are reset to their defaults when the interface is enumerated. + */ + } USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Configures the endpoints of a given Mass Storage interface, ready for use. This should be linked to the library + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged() event so that the endpoints are configured when the configuration + * containing the given Mass Storage interface is selected. + * + * \param[in,out] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Mass Storage Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the endpoints were successfully configured, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool MS_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Processes incoming control requests from the host, that are directed to the given Mass Storage class interface. This should be + * linked to the library \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event. + * + * \param[in,out] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Mass Storage Class configuration and state. + */ + void MS_Device_ProcessControlRequest(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** General management task for a given Mass Storage class interface, required for the correct operation of the interface. This should + * be called frequently in the main program loop, before the master USB management task \ref USB_USBTask(). + * + * \param[in,out] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Mass Storage configuration and state. + */ + void MS_Device_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Mass Storage class driver callback for the user processing of a received SCSI command. This callback will fire each time the + * host sends a SCSI command which requires processing by the user application. Inside this callback the user is responsible + * for the processing of the received SCSI command from the host. The SCSI command is available in the CommandBlock structure + * inside the Mass Storage class state structure passed as a parameter to the callback function. + * + * \param[in,out] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Mass Storage Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the SCSI command was successfully processed, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool CALLBACK_MS_Device_SCSICommandReceived(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_MASSSTORAGE_DEVICE_C) + static void MS_Device_ReturnCommandStatus(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static bool MS_Device_ReadInCommandBlock(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + #endif + + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/PrinterClassDevice.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/PrinterClassDevice.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7209c452dc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/PrinterClassDevice.c @@ -0,0 +1,314 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../../Core/USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_PRINTER_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_PRINTER_DEVICE_C +#include "PrinterClassDevice.h" + +void PRNT_Device_ProcessControlRequest(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) +{ + if (!(Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived())) + return; + + if (USB_ControlRequest.wIndex != PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.InterfaceNumber) + return; + + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case PRNT_REQ_GetDeviceID: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + + uint16_t IEEEStringLen = strlen(PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.IEEE1284String); + Endpoint_Write_16_BE(IEEEStringLen); + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.IEEE1284String, IEEEStringLen); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + case PRNT_REQ_GetPortStatus: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + + Endpoint_Write_8(PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.PortStatus); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + } + + break; + case PRNT_REQ_SoftReset: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.IsPrinterReset = true; + + EVENT_PRNT_Device_SoftReset(PRNTInterfaceInfo); + } + + break; + } +} + +bool PRNT_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) +{ + memset(&PRNTInterfaceInfo->State, 0x00, sizeof(PRNTInterfaceInfo->State)); + PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.PortStatus = PRNT_PORTSTATUS_NOTERROR | PRNT_PORTSTATUS_SELECT; + + PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + + if (!(Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(&PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint, 1))) + return false; + + if (!(Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(&PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint, 1))) + return false; + + return true; +} + +void PRNT_Device_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) +{ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + #if !defined(NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH) + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + + if (Endpoint_IsINReady()) + PRNT_Device_Flush(PRNTInterfaceInfo); + #endif + + if (PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.IsPrinterReset) + { + Endpoint_ResetEndpoint(PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Address); + Endpoint_ResetEndpoint(PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Address); + Endpoint_ClearStall(); + Endpoint_ResetDataToggle(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + Endpoint_ClearStall(); + Endpoint_ResetDataToggle(); + + PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.IsPrinterReset = false; + } +} + +uint8_t PRNT_Device_SendString(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + const char* const String) +{ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + return Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(String, strlen(String), NULL); +} + +uint8_t PRNT_Device_SendData(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + const void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) +{ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + return Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(Buffer, Length, NULL); +} + +uint8_t PRNT_Device_SendByte(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t Data) +{ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) != ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + } + + Endpoint_Write_8(Data); + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError; +} + +uint8_t PRNT_Device_Flush(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) +{ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + + if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint())) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError; + + bool BankFull = !(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed()); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + if (BankFull) + { + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) != ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } + + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError; +} + +uint16_t PRNT_Device_BytesReceived(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) +{ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return 0; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Address); + + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + { + if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint())) + { + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + return 0; + } + else + { + return Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint(); + } + } + else + { + return 0; + } +} + +int16_t PRNT_Device_ReceiveByte(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) +{ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return -1; + + int16_t ReceivedByte = -1; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Address); + + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + { + if (Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint()) + ReceivedByte = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint())) + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + + return ReceivedByte; +} + +#if defined(FDEV_SETUP_STREAM) +void PRNT_Device_CreateStream(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + FILE* const Stream) +{ + *Stream = (FILE)FDEV_SETUP_STREAM(PRNT_Device_putchar, PRNT_Device_getchar, _FDEV_SETUP_RW); + fdev_set_udata(Stream, PRNTInterfaceInfo); +} + +void PRNT_Device_CreateBlockingStream(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + FILE* const Stream) +{ + *Stream = (FILE)FDEV_SETUP_STREAM(PRNT_Device_putchar, PRNT_Device_getchar_Blocking, _FDEV_SETUP_RW); + fdev_set_udata(Stream, PRNTInterfaceInfo); +} + +static int PRNT_Device_putchar(char c, + FILE* Stream) +{ + return PRNT_Device_SendByte((USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t*)fdev_get_udata(Stream), c) ? _FDEV_ERR : 0; +} + +static int PRNT_Device_getchar(FILE* Stream) +{ + int16_t ReceivedByte = PRNT_Device_ReceiveByte((USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t*)fdev_get_udata(Stream)); + + if (ReceivedByte < 0) + return _FDEV_EOF; + + return ReceivedByte; +} + +static int PRNT_Device_getchar_Blocking(FILE* Stream) +{ + int16_t ReceivedByte; + + while ((ReceivedByte = PRNT_Device_ReceiveByte((USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t*)fdev_get_udata(Stream))) < 0) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return _FDEV_EOF; + + PRNT_Device_USBTask((USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t*)fdev_get_udata(Stream)); + USB_USBTask(); + } + + return ReceivedByte; +} +#endif + +void PRNT_Device_Event_Stub(void) +{ + +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/PrinterClassDevice.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/PrinterClassDevice.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..802c5912d3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/PrinterClassDevice.h @@ -0,0 +1,293 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Device mode driver for the library USB Printer Class driver. + * + * Device mode driver for the library USB Printer Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassPrinter + * \defgroup Group_USBClassPrinterDevice Printer Class Device Mode Driver + * + * \section Sec_USBClassPrinterDevice_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/PrinterClassDevice.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassPrinterDevice_ModDescription Module Description + * Device Mode USB Class driver framework interface, for the Printer USB Class driver. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _PRINTER_CLASS_DEVICE_H_ +#define _PRINTER_CLASS_DEVICE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../USB.h" + #include "../Common/PrinterClassCommon.h" + + #include <stdio.h> + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_PRINTER_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief Printer Class Device Mode Configuration and State Structure. + * + * Class state structure. An instance of this structure should be made for each Printer interface + * within the user application, and passed to each of the Printer class driver functions as the + * PRNTInterfaceInfo parameter. This stores each Printer interface's configuration and state information. + */ + typedef struct + { + struct + { + uint8_t InterfaceNumber; /**< Interface number of the Printer interface within the device. */ + + USB_Endpoint_Table_t DataINEndpoint; /**< Data IN endpoint configuration table. */ + USB_Endpoint_Table_t DataOUTEndpoint; /**< Data OUT endpoint configuration table. */ + + char* IEEE1284String; /**< IEEE 1284 identification string, sent to the host during enumeration + * to identify the printer model, manufacturer and other characteristics. + */ + } Config; /**< Config data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>must</b> be set or the interface will fail to enumerate and operate correctly. + */ + struct + { + uint8_t PortStatus; /**< Current status of the Printer virtual port, a collection of \c PRNT_PORTSTATUS_* + * bitmask values. + */ + + volatile bool IsPrinterReset; /**< Flag indicating that the host has requested that the Printer interface be reset + * and that all current Mass Storage operations should immediately abort. + */ + } State; /**< State data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * are reset to their defaults when the interface is enumerated. + */ + } USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Configures the endpoints of a given Printer interface, ready for use. This should be linked to the library + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged() event so that the endpoints are configured when the configuration containing + * the given Printer interface is selected. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the endpoints were successfully configured, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool PRNT_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Processes incoming control requests from the host, that are directed to the given Printer class interface. This should be + * linked to the library \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class configuration and state. + */ + void PRNT_Device_ProcessControlRequest(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** General management task for a given Printer class interface, required for the correct operation of the interface. This should + * be called frequently in the main program loop, before the master USB management task \ref USB_USBTask(). + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class configuration and state. + */ + void PRNT_Device_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Printer class driver event for a soft reset request on a Printer interface. This event fires each time the host + * requests a reset of the printer interface's internal state, and may be hooked in the user program by declaring a + * handler function with the same name and parameters listed here. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class configuration and state. + */ + void EVENT_PRNT_Device_SoftReset(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sends a given data buffer to the attached USB host, if connected. If a host is not connected when the function is + * called, the string is discarded. Bytes will be queued for transmission to the host until either the endpoint bank + * becomes full, or the \ref PRNT_Device_Flush() function is called to flush the pending data to the host. This allows + * for multiple bytes to be packed into a single endpoint packet, increasing data throughput. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to a buffer containing the data to send to the device. + * \param[in] Length Length of the data to send to the host. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t PRNT_Device_SendData(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + const void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Sends a given null terminated string to the attached USB host, if connected. If a host is not connected when + * the function is called, the string is discarded. Bytes will be queued for transmission to the host until either + * the endpoint bank becomes full, or the \ref PRNT_Device_Flush() function is called to flush the pending data to + * the host. This allows for multiple bytes to be packed into a single endpoint packet, increasing data throughput. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] String Pointer to the null terminated string to send to the host. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t PRNT_Device_SendString(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + const char* const String) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Sends a given byte to the attached USB host, if connected. If a host is not connected when the function is called, the + * byte is discarded. Bytes will be queued for transmission to the host until either the endpoint bank becomes full, or the + * \ref PRNT_Device_Flush() function is called to flush the pending data to the host. This allows for multiple bytes to be + * packed into a single endpoint packet, increasing data throughput. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] Data Byte of data to send to the host. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t PRNT_Device_SendByte(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t Data) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Determines the number of bytes received by the Printer interface from the host, waiting to be read. This indicates the number + * of bytes in the OUT endpoint bank only, and thus the number of calls to \ref PRNT_Device_ReceiveByte() which are guaranteed to + * succeed immediately. If multiple bytes are to be received, they should be buffered by the user application, as the endpoint + * bank will not be released back to the USB controller until all bytes are read. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Total number of buffered bytes received from the host. + */ + uint16_t PRNT_Device_BytesReceived(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads a byte of data from the host. If no data is waiting to be read of if a USB host is not connected, the function + * returns a negative value. The \ref PRNT_Device_BytesReceived() function may be queried in advance to determine how many + * bytes are currently buffered in the Printer interface's data receive endpoint bank, and thus how many repeated calls to this + * function which are guaranteed to succeed. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Next received byte from the host, or a negative value if no data received. + */ + int16_t PRNT_Device_ReceiveByte(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Flushes any data waiting to be sent, ensuring that the send buffer is cleared. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class configuration and state. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t PRNT_Device_Flush(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + #if defined(FDEV_SETUP_STREAM) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Creates a standard character stream for the given Printer Device instance so that it can be used with all the regular + * functions in the standard <stdio.h> library that accept a \c FILE stream as a destination (e.g. \c fprintf()). The created + * stream is bidirectional and can be used for both input and output functions. + * + * Reading data from this stream is non-blocking, i.e. in most instances, complete strings cannot be read in by a single + * fetch, as the endpoint will not be ready at some point in the transmission, aborting the transfer. However, this may + * be used when the read data is processed byte-per-bye (via \c getc()) or when the user application will implement its own + * line buffering. + * + * \note The created stream can be given as \c stdout if desired to direct the standard output from all \c <stdio.h> functions + * to the given Printer interface. + * \n\n + * + * \note This function is not available on all microcontroller architectures. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class configuration and state. + * \param[in,out] Stream Pointer to a FILE structure where the created stream should be placed. + */ + void PRNT_Device_CreateStream(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + FILE* const Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Identical to \ref PRNT_Device_CreateStream(), except that reads are blocking until the calling stream function terminates + * the transfer. While blocking, the USB and Printer service tasks are called repeatedly to maintain USB communications. + * + * \note This function is not available on all microcontroller architectures. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class configuration and state. + * \param[in,out] Stream Pointer to a FILE structure where the created stream should be placed. + */ + void PRNT_Device_CreateBlockingStream(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + FILE* const Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_PRINTER_DEVICE_C) + #if defined(FDEV_SETUP_STREAM) + static int PRNT_Device_putchar(char c, + FILE* Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + static int PRNT_Device_getchar(FILE* Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static int PRNT_Device_getchar_Blocking(FILE* Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + #endif + + void PRNT_Device_Event_Stub(void) ATTR_CONST; + + void EVENT_PRNT_Device_SoftReset(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Device_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) + ATTR_WEAK ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALIAS(PRNT_Device_Event_Stub); + + #endif + + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/RNDISClassDevice.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/RNDISClassDevice.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..45293b12fc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/RNDISClassDevice.c @@ -0,0 +1,508 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../../Core/USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_RNDIS_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_RNDIS_DEVICE_C +#include "RNDISClassDevice.h" + +static const uint32_t PROGMEM AdapterSupportedOIDList[] = + { + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_SUPPORTED_LIST), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_PHYSICAL_MEDIUM), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_HARDWARE_STATUS), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_MEDIA_SUPPORTED), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_MEDIA_IN_USE), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_MAXIMUM_FRAME_SIZE), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_MAXIMUM_TOTAL_SIZE), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_LINK_SPEED), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_TRANSMIT_BLOCK_SIZE), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_RECEIVE_BLOCK_SIZE), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_VENDOR_ID), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_VENDOR_DESCRIPTION), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_CURRENT_PACKET_FILTER), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_MAXIMUM_TOTAL_SIZE), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_MEDIA_CONNECT_STATUS), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_XMIT_OK), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_RCV_OK), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_XMIT_ERROR), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_RCV_ERROR), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_GEN_RCV_NO_BUFFER), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_802_3_PERMANENT_ADDRESS), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_802_3_CURRENT_ADDRESS), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_802_3_MULTICAST_LIST), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_802_3_MAXIMUM_LIST_SIZE), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_802_3_RCV_ERROR_ALIGNMENT), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_802_3_XMIT_ONE_COLLISION), + CPU_TO_LE32(OID_802_3_XMIT_MORE_COLLISIONS), + }; + +void RNDIS_Device_ProcessControlRequest(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo) +{ + if (!(Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived())) + return; + + if (USB_ControlRequest.wIndex != RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.ControlInterfaceNumber) + return; + + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case RNDIS_REQ_SendEncapsulatedCommand: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE(RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBuffer, USB_ControlRequest.wLength); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + RNDIS_Device_ProcessRNDISControlMessage(RNDISInterfaceInfo); + } + + break; + case RNDIS_REQ_GetEncapsulatedResponse: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + RNDIS_Message_Header_t* MessageHeader = (RNDIS_Message_Header_t*)RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBuffer; + + if (!(MessageHeader->MessageLength)) + { + RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBuffer[0] = 0; + MessageHeader->MessageLength = CPU_TO_LE32(1); + } + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBuffer, le32_to_cpu(MessageHeader->MessageLength)); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + MessageHeader->MessageLength = CPU_TO_LE32(0); + } + + break; + } +} + +bool RNDIS_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo) +{ + memset(&RNDISInterfaceInfo->State, 0x00, sizeof(RNDISInterfaceInfo->State)); + + RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.NotificationEndpoint.Type = EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT; + + if (RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBuffer == NULL) + return false; + + if (RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBufferLength < RNDIS_DEVICE_MIN_MESSAGE_BUFFER_LENGTH) + return false; + + if (!(Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(&RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint, 1))) + return false; + + if (!(Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(&RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint, 1))) + return false; + + if (!(Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(&RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.NotificationEndpoint, 1))) + return false; + + return true; +} + +void RNDIS_Device_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo) +{ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.NotificationEndpoint.Address); + + if (Endpoint_IsINReady() && RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.ResponseReady) + { + USB_Request_Header_t Notification = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = RNDIS_NOTIF_ResponseAvailable, + .wValue = CPU_TO_LE16(0), + .wIndex = CPU_TO_LE16(0), + .wLength = CPU_TO_LE16(0), + }; + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&Notification, sizeof(USB_Request_Header_t), NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.ResponseReady = false; + } +} + +void RNDIS_Device_ProcessRNDISControlMessage(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo) +{ + /* Note: Only a single buffer is used for both the received message and its response to save SRAM. Because of + this, response bytes should be filled in order so that they do not clobber unread data in the buffer. */ + + RNDIS_Message_Header_t* MessageHeader = (RNDIS_Message_Header_t*)RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBuffer; + + switch (le32_to_cpu(MessageHeader->MessageType)) + { + case REMOTE_NDIS_INITIALIZE_MSG: + RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.ResponseReady = true; + + RNDIS_Initialize_Message_t* INITIALIZE_Message = + (RNDIS_Initialize_Message_t*)RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBuffer; + RNDIS_Initialize_Complete_t* INITIALIZE_Response = + (RNDIS_Initialize_Complete_t*)RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBuffer; + + INITIALIZE_Response->MessageType = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_INITIALIZE_CMPLT); + INITIALIZE_Response->MessageLength = CPU_TO_LE32(sizeof(RNDIS_Initialize_Complete_t)); + INITIALIZE_Response->RequestId = INITIALIZE_Message->RequestId; + INITIALIZE_Response->Status = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_SUCCESS); + + INITIALIZE_Response->MajorVersion = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_VERSION_MAJOR); + INITIALIZE_Response->MinorVersion = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_VERSION_MINOR); + INITIALIZE_Response->DeviceFlags = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_DF_CONNECTIONLESS); + INITIALIZE_Response->Medium = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_MEDIUM_802_3); + INITIALIZE_Response->MaxPacketsPerTransfer = CPU_TO_LE32(1); + INITIALIZE_Response->MaxTransferSize = CPU_TO_LE32(sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t) + ETHERNET_FRAME_SIZE_MAX); + INITIALIZE_Response->PacketAlignmentFactor = CPU_TO_LE32(0); + INITIALIZE_Response->AFListOffset = CPU_TO_LE32(0); + INITIALIZE_Response->AFListSize = CPU_TO_LE32(0); + + RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.CurrRNDISState = RNDIS_Initialized; + break; + case REMOTE_NDIS_HALT_MSG: + RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.ResponseReady = false; + + MessageHeader->MessageLength = CPU_TO_LE32(0); + + RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.CurrRNDISState = RNDIS_Uninitialized; + break; + case REMOTE_NDIS_QUERY_MSG: + RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.ResponseReady = true; + + RNDIS_Query_Message_t* QUERY_Message = (RNDIS_Query_Message_t*)RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBuffer; + RNDIS_Query_Complete_t* QUERY_Response = (RNDIS_Query_Complete_t*)RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBuffer; + uint32_t Query_Oid = CPU_TO_LE32(QUERY_Message->Oid); + + void* QueryData = &RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBuffer[sizeof(RNDIS_Message_Header_t) + + le32_to_cpu(QUERY_Message->InformationBufferOffset)]; + void* ResponseData = &RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBuffer[sizeof(RNDIS_Query_Complete_t)]; + uint16_t ResponseSize; + + QUERY_Response->MessageType = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_QUERY_CMPLT); + + if (RNDIS_Device_ProcessNDISQuery(RNDISInterfaceInfo, Query_Oid, QueryData, le32_to_cpu(QUERY_Message->InformationBufferLength), + ResponseData, &ResponseSize)) + { + QUERY_Response->Status = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_SUCCESS); + QUERY_Response->MessageLength = cpu_to_le32(sizeof(RNDIS_Query_Complete_t) + ResponseSize); + + QUERY_Response->InformationBufferLength = CPU_TO_LE32(ResponseSize); + QUERY_Response->InformationBufferOffset = CPU_TO_LE32(sizeof(RNDIS_Query_Complete_t) - sizeof(RNDIS_Message_Header_t)); + } + else + { + QUERY_Response->Status = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_NOT_SUPPORTED); + QUERY_Response->MessageLength = CPU_TO_LE32(sizeof(RNDIS_Query_Complete_t)); + + QUERY_Response->InformationBufferLength = CPU_TO_LE32(0); + QUERY_Response->InformationBufferOffset = CPU_TO_LE32(0); + } + + break; + case REMOTE_NDIS_SET_MSG: + RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.ResponseReady = true; + + RNDIS_Set_Message_t* SET_Message = (RNDIS_Set_Message_t*)RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBuffer; + RNDIS_Set_Complete_t* SET_Response = (RNDIS_Set_Complete_t*)RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBuffer; + uint32_t SET_Oid = le32_to_cpu(SET_Message->Oid); + + SET_Response->MessageType = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_SET_CMPLT); + SET_Response->MessageLength = CPU_TO_LE32(sizeof(RNDIS_Set_Complete_t)); + SET_Response->RequestId = SET_Message->RequestId; + + void* SetData = &RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBuffer[sizeof(RNDIS_Message_Header_t) + + le32_to_cpu(SET_Message->InformationBufferOffset)]; + + SET_Response->Status = RNDIS_Device_ProcessNDISSet(RNDISInterfaceInfo, SET_Oid, SetData, + le32_to_cpu(SET_Message->InformationBufferLength)) ? + REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_SUCCESS : REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_NOT_SUPPORTED; + break; + case REMOTE_NDIS_RESET_MSG: + RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.ResponseReady = true; + + RNDIS_Reset_Complete_t* RESET_Response = (RNDIS_Reset_Complete_t*)RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBuffer; + + RESET_Response->MessageType = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_RESET_CMPLT); + RESET_Response->MessageLength = CPU_TO_LE32(sizeof(RNDIS_Reset_Complete_t)); + RESET_Response->Status = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_SUCCESS); + RESET_Response->AddressingReset = CPU_TO_LE32(0); + + break; + case REMOTE_NDIS_KEEPALIVE_MSG: + RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.ResponseReady = true; + + RNDIS_KeepAlive_Message_t* KEEPALIVE_Message = + (RNDIS_KeepAlive_Message_t*)RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBuffer; + RNDIS_KeepAlive_Complete_t* KEEPALIVE_Response = + (RNDIS_KeepAlive_Complete_t*)RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBuffer; + + KEEPALIVE_Response->MessageType = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_KEEPALIVE_CMPLT); + KEEPALIVE_Response->MessageLength = CPU_TO_LE32(sizeof(RNDIS_KeepAlive_Complete_t)); + KEEPALIVE_Response->RequestId = KEEPALIVE_Message->RequestId; + KEEPALIVE_Response->Status = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_SUCCESS); + + break; + } +} + +static bool RNDIS_Device_ProcessNDISQuery(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t OId, + void* const QueryData, + const uint16_t QuerySize, + void* ResponseData, + uint16_t* const ResponseSize) +{ + (void)QueryData; + (void)QuerySize; + + switch (OId) + { + case OID_GEN_SUPPORTED_LIST: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(AdapterSupportedOIDList); + + memcpy_P(ResponseData, AdapterSupportedOIDList, sizeof(AdapterSupportedOIDList)); + + return true; + case OID_GEN_PHYSICAL_MEDIUM: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + /* Indicate that the device is a true ethernet link */ + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = CPU_TO_LE32(0); + + return true; + case OID_GEN_HARDWARE_STATUS: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = CPU_TO_LE32(NDIS_HardwareStatus_Ready); + + return true; + case OID_GEN_MEDIA_SUPPORTED: + case OID_GEN_MEDIA_IN_USE: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_MEDIUM_802_3); + + return true; + case OID_GEN_VENDOR_ID: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + /* Vendor ID 0x0xFFFFFF is reserved for vendors who have not purchased a NDIS VID */ + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = CPU_TO_LE32(0x00FFFFFF); + + return true; + case OID_GEN_MAXIMUM_FRAME_SIZE: + case OID_GEN_TRANSMIT_BLOCK_SIZE: + case OID_GEN_RECEIVE_BLOCK_SIZE: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = CPU_TO_LE32(ETHERNET_FRAME_SIZE_MAX); + + return true; + case OID_GEN_VENDOR_DESCRIPTION: + *ResponseSize = (strlen(RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.AdapterVendorDescription) + 1); + + memcpy(ResponseData, RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.AdapterVendorDescription, *ResponseSize); + + return true; + case OID_GEN_MEDIA_CONNECT_STATUS: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_MEDIA_STATE_CONNECTED); + + return true; + case OID_GEN_LINK_SPEED: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + /* Indicate 10Mb/s link speed */ + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = CPU_TO_LE32(100000); + + return true; + case OID_802_3_PERMANENT_ADDRESS: + case OID_802_3_CURRENT_ADDRESS: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(MAC_Address_t); + + memcpy(ResponseData, &RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.AdapterMACAddress, sizeof(MAC_Address_t)); + + return true; + case OID_802_3_MAXIMUM_LIST_SIZE: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + /* Indicate only one multicast address supported */ + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = CPU_TO_LE32(1); + + return true; + case OID_GEN_CURRENT_PACKET_FILTER: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = cpu_to_le32(RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.CurrPacketFilter); + + return true; + case OID_GEN_XMIT_OK: + case OID_GEN_RCV_OK: + case OID_GEN_XMIT_ERROR: + case OID_GEN_RCV_ERROR: + case OID_GEN_RCV_NO_BUFFER: + case OID_802_3_RCV_ERROR_ALIGNMENT: + case OID_802_3_XMIT_ONE_COLLISION: + case OID_802_3_XMIT_MORE_COLLISIONS: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + /* Unused statistic OIDs - always return 0 for each */ + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = CPU_TO_LE32(0); + + return true; + case OID_GEN_MAXIMUM_TOTAL_SIZE: + *ResponseSize = sizeof(uint32_t); + + /* Indicate maximum overall buffer (Ethernet frame and RNDIS header) the adapter can handle */ + *((uint32_t*)ResponseData) = CPU_TO_LE32(RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.MessageBufferLength + ETHERNET_FRAME_SIZE_MAX); + + return true; + default: + return false; + } +} + +static bool RNDIS_Device_ProcessNDISSet(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t OId, + const void* SetData, + const uint16_t SetSize) +{ + (void)SetSize; + + switch (OId) + { + case OID_GEN_CURRENT_PACKET_FILTER: + RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.CurrPacketFilter = le32_to_cpu(*((uint32_t*)SetData)); + RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.CurrRNDISState = (RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.CurrPacketFilter) ? RNDIS_Data_Initialized : RNDIS_Initialized; + + return true; + case OID_802_3_MULTICAST_LIST: + /* Do nothing - throw away the value from the host as it is unused */ + + return true; + default: + return false; + } +} + +bool RNDIS_Device_IsPacketReceived(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) || + (RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.CurrRNDISState != RNDIS_Data_Initialized)) + { + return false; + } + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Address); + return Endpoint_IsOUTReceived(); +} + +uint8_t RNDIS_Device_ReadPacket(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + void* Buffer, + uint16_t* const PacketLength) +{ + if ((USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) || + (RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.CurrRNDISState != RNDIS_Data_Initialized)) + { + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + } + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTEndpoint.Address); + + *PacketLength = 0; + + if (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError; + + RNDIS_Packet_Message_t RNDISPacketHeader; + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&RNDISPacketHeader, sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t), NULL); + + if (le32_to_cpu(RNDISPacketHeader.DataLength) > ETHERNET_FRAME_SIZE_MAX) + { + Endpoint_StallTransaction(); + + return RNDIS_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED; + } + + *PacketLength = (uint16_t)le32_to_cpu(RNDISPacketHeader.DataLength); + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(Buffer, *PacketLength, NULL); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +uint8_t RNDIS_Device_SendPacket(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t PacketLength) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) || + (RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.CurrRNDISState != RNDIS_Data_Initialized)) + { + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + } + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) != ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + RNDIS_Packet_Message_t RNDISPacketHeader; + + memset(&RNDISPacketHeader, 0, sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t)); + + RNDISPacketHeader.MessageType = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_MSG); + RNDISPacketHeader.MessageLength = cpu_to_le32(sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t) + PacketLength); + RNDISPacketHeader.DataOffset = CPU_TO_LE32(sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t) - sizeof(RNDIS_Message_Header_t)); + RNDISPacketHeader.DataLength = cpu_to_le32(PacketLength); + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&RNDISPacketHeader, sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t), NULL); + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(Buffer, PacketLength, NULL); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/RNDISClassDevice.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/RNDISClassDevice.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..761bc2790f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/RNDISClassDevice.h @@ -0,0 +1,207 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Device mode driver for the library USB RNDIS Class driver. + * + * Device mode driver for the library USB RNDIS Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassRNDIS + * \defgroup Group_USBClassRNDISDevice RNDIS Class Device Mode Driver + * + * \section Sec_USBClassRNDISDevice_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/RNDISClassDevice.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassRNDISDevice_ModDescription Module Description + * Device Mode USB Class driver framework interface, for the RNDIS USB Class driver. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _RNDIS_CLASS_DEVICE_H_ +#define _RNDIS_CLASS_DEVICE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../USB.h" + #include "../Common/RNDISClassCommon.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_RNDIS_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief RNDIS Class Device Mode Configuration and State Structure. + * + * Class state structure. An instance of this structure should be made for each RNDIS interface + * within the user application, and passed to each of the RNDIS class driver functions as the + * \c RNDISInterfaceInfo parameter. This stores each RNDIS interface's configuration and state information. + */ + typedef struct + { + struct + { + uint8_t ControlInterfaceNumber; /**< Interface number of the RNDIS control interface within the device. */ + + USB_Endpoint_Table_t DataINEndpoint; /**< Data IN endpoint configuration table. */ + USB_Endpoint_Table_t DataOUTEndpoint; /**< Data OUT endpoint configuration table. */ + USB_Endpoint_Table_t NotificationEndpoint; /**< Notification IN Endpoint configuration table. */ + + char* AdapterVendorDescription; /**< String description of the adapter vendor. */ + MAC_Address_t AdapterMACAddress; /**< MAC address of the adapter. */ + + uint8_t* MessageBuffer; /**< Buffer where RNDIS messages can be stored by the internal driver. This + * should be at least 132 bytes in length for minimal functionality. */ + uint16_t MessageBufferLength; /**< Length in bytes of the \ref MessageBuffer RNDIS buffer. */ + } Config; /**< Config data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>must</b> be set or the interface will fail to enumerate and operate correctly. + */ + struct + { + bool ResponseReady; /**< Internal flag indicating if a RNDIS message is waiting to be returned to the host. */ + uint8_t CurrRNDISState; /**< Current RNDIS state of the adapter, a value from the \ref RNDIS_States_t enum. */ + uint32_t CurrPacketFilter; /**< Current packet filter mode, used internally by the class driver. */ + } State; /**< State data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * are reset to their defaults when the interface is enumerated. + */ + } USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Configures the endpoints of a given RNDIS interface, ready for use. This should be linked to the library + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged() event so that the endpoints are configured when the configuration + * containing the given RNDIS interface is selected. + * + * \param[in,out] RNDISInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a RNDIS Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the endpoints were successfully configured, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool RNDIS_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Processes incoming control requests from the host, that are directed to the given RNDIS class interface. This should be + * linked to the library \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event. + * + * \param[in,out] RNDISInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a RNDIS Class configuration and state. + */ + void RNDIS_Device_ProcessControlRequest(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** General management task for a given RNDIS class interface, required for the correct operation of the interface. This should + * be called frequently in the main program loop, before the master USB management task \ref USB_USBTask(). + * + * \param[in,out] RNDISInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a RNDIS Class configuration and state. + */ + void RNDIS_Device_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Determines if a packet is currently waiting for the device to read in and process. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] RNDISInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an RNDIS Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if a packet is waiting to be read in by the host, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool RNDIS_Device_IsPacketReceived(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Retrieves the next pending packet from the device, discarding the remainder of the RNDIS packet header to leave + * only the packet contents for processing by the device in the nominated buffer. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] RNDISInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an RNDIS Class configuration and state. + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to a buffer where the packer data is to be written to. + * \param[out] PacketLength Pointer to where the length in bytes of the read packet is to be stored. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t RNDIS_Device_ReadPacket(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + void* Buffer, + uint16_t* const PacketLength) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sends the given packet to the attached RNDIS device, after adding a RNDIS packet message header. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Device state machine is in the \ref DEVICE_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] RNDISInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an RNDIS Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to a buffer where the packer data is to be read from. + * \param[in] PacketLength Length in bytes of the packet to send. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t RNDIS_Device_SendPacket(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t PacketLength) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define RNDIS_DEVICE_MIN_MESSAGE_BUFFER_LENGTH sizeof(AdapterSupportedOIDList) + sizeof(RNDIS_Query_Complete_t) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_RNDIS_DEVICE_C) + static void RNDIS_Device_ProcessRNDISControlMessage(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static bool RNDIS_Device_ProcessNDISQuery(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t OId, + void* const QueryData, + const uint16_t QuerySize, + void* ResponseData, + uint16_t* const ResponseSize) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(5) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(6); + static bool RNDIS_Device_ProcessNDISSet(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t OId, + const void* SetData, + const uint16_t SetSize) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + #endif + + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/HIDClass.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/HIDClass.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..158eb256b6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/HIDClass.h @@ -0,0 +1,82 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Master include file for the library USB HID Class driver. + * + * Master include file for the library USB HID Class driver, for both host and device modes, where available. + * + * This file should be included in all user projects making use of this optional class driver, instead of + * including any headers in the USB/ClassDriver/Device, USB/ClassDriver/Host or USB/ClassDriver/Common subdirectories. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassDrivers + * \defgroup Group_USBClassHID HID Class Driver + * \brief USB class driver for the USB-IF Human Interface Device (HID) class standard. + * + * \section Sec_USBClassHID_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/HIDClassDevice.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/HIDClassHost.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/HIDParser.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USB)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassHID_ModDescription Module Description + * HID Class Driver module. This module contains an internal implementation of the USB HID Class, for both Device + * and Host USB modes. User applications can use this class driver instead of implementing the HID class manually + * via the low-level LUFA APIs. + * + * This module is designed to simplify the user code by exposing only the required interface needed to interface with + * Hosts or Devices using the USB HID Class. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _HID_CLASS_H_ +#define _HID_CLASS_H_ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_HID_DRIVER + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../Core/USBMode.h" + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + #include "Device/HIDClassDevice.h" + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + #include "Host/HIDClassHost.h" + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AndroidAccessoryClassHost.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AndroidAccessoryClassHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ea89033668 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AndroidAccessoryClassHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,422 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../../Core/USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_AOA_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_ANDROIDACCESSORY_HOST_C +#include "AndroidAccessoryClassHost.h" + +bool AOA_Host_ValidateAccessoryDevice(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo, + const USB_Descriptor_Device_t* const DeviceDescriptor, + bool* const NeedModeSwitch) +{ + (void)AOAInterfaceInfo; + + if (DeviceDescriptor->Header.Type != DTYPE_Device) + return false; + + *NeedModeSwitch = ((DeviceDescriptor->ProductID != ANDROID_ACCESSORY_PRODUCT_ID) && + (DeviceDescriptor->ProductID != ANDROID_ACCESSORY_ADB_PRODUCT_ID)); + + return true; +} + +uint8_t AOA_Host_ConfigurePipes(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo, + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize, + void* ConfigDescriptorData) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* AOAInterface = NULL; + + memset(&AOAInterfaceInfo->State, 0x00, sizeof(AOAInterfaceInfo->State)); + + if (DESCRIPTOR_TYPE(ConfigDescriptorData) != DTYPE_Configuration) + return AOA_ENUMERROR_InvalidConfigDescriptor; + + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_AOA_Host_NextAndroidAccessoryInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + return AOA_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + AOAInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + while (!(DataINEndpoint) || !(DataOUTEndpoint)) + { + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_AOA_Host_NextInterfaceBulkEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + return AOA_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + else + DataOUTEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + + AOAInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize); + AOAInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.EndpointAddress = DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + AOAInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + + AOAInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointSize); + AOAInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.EndpointAddress = DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + AOAInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&AOAInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe, 1))) + return AOA_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&AOAInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe, 1))) + return AOA_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + AOAInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive = true; + AOAInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceNumber = AOAInterface->InterfaceNumber; + + return AOA_ENUMERROR_NoError; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_AOA_Host_NextAndroidAccessoryInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + if ((Interface->Class == AOA_CSCP_AOADataClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == AOA_CSCP_AOADataSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == AOA_CSCP_AOADataProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_AOA_Host_NextInterfaceBulkEndpoint(void* const CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* Endpoint = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + uint8_t EndpointType = (Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK); + + if ((EndpointType == EP_TYPE_BULK) && (!(Pipe_IsEndpointBound(Endpoint->EndpointAddress)))) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +void AOA_Host_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(AOAInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return; + + #if !defined(NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH) + AOA_Host_Flush(AOAInterfaceInfo); + #endif +} + +uint8_t AOA_Host_StartAccessoryMode(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + uint16_t AccessoryProtocol; + if ((ErrorCode = AOA_Host_GetAccessoryProtocol(&AccessoryProtocol)) != HOST_WAITERROR_Successful) + return ErrorCode; + + if ((AccessoryProtocol != CPU_TO_LE16(AOA_PROTOCOL_AccessoryV1)) && (AccessoryProtocol != CPU_TO_LE16(AOA_PROTOCOL_AccessoryV2))) + return AOA_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED; + + for (uint8_t PropertyIndex = 0; PropertyIndex < AOA_STRING_TOTAL_STRINGS; PropertyIndex++) + { + if ((ErrorCode = AOA_Host_SendPropertyString(AOAInterfaceInfo, PropertyIndex)) != HOST_WAITERROR_Successful) + return ErrorCode; + } + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_VENDOR | REQREC_DEVICE), + .bRequest = AOA_REQ_StartAccessoryMode, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(NULL); +} + +static uint8_t AOA_Host_GetAccessoryProtocol(uint16_t* const Protocol) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_VENDOR | REQREC_DEVICE), + .bRequest = AOA_REQ_GetAccessoryProtocol, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = sizeof(uint16_t), + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(Protocol); +} + +static uint8_t AOA_Host_SendPropertyString(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t StringIndex) +{ + const char* String = AOAInterfaceInfo->Config.PropertyStrings[StringIndex]; + + if (String == NULL) + String = ""; + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_VENDOR | REQREC_DEVICE), + .bRequest = AOA_REQ_SendString, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = StringIndex, + .wLength = (strlen(String) + 1), + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest((char*)String); +} + +uint8_t AOA_Host_SendData(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo, + const void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(AOAInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(AOAInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(Buffer, Length, NULL); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return ErrorCode; +} + +uint8_t AOA_Host_SendString(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo, + const char* const String) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(AOAInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(AOAInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(String, strlen(String), NULL); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return ErrorCode; +} + +uint8_t AOA_Host_SendByte(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t Data) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(AOAInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(AOAInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (!(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady()) != PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + } + + Pipe_Write_8(Data); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError; +} + +uint16_t AOA_Host_BytesReceived(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(AOAInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return 0; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(AOAInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + { + if (!(Pipe_BytesInPipe())) + { + Pipe_ClearIN(); + Pipe_Freeze(); + return 0; + } + else + { + Pipe_Freeze(); + return Pipe_BytesInPipe(); + } + } + else + { + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return 0; + } +} + +int16_t AOA_Host_ReceiveByte(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(AOAInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return -1; + + int16_t ReceivedByte = -1; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(AOAInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + { + if (Pipe_BytesInPipe()) + ReceivedByte = Pipe_Read_8(); + + if (!(Pipe_BytesInPipe())) + Pipe_ClearIN(); + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return ReceivedByte; +} + +uint8_t AOA_Host_Flush(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(AOAInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(AOAInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (!(Pipe_BytesInPipe())) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError; + + bool BankFull = !(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed()); + + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + if (BankFull) + { + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady()) != PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError; +} + +#if defined(FDEV_SETUP_STREAM) +void AOA_Host_CreateStream(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo, + FILE* const Stream) +{ + *Stream = (FILE)FDEV_SETUP_STREAM(AOA_Host_putchar, AOA_Host_getchar, _FDEV_SETUP_RW); + fdev_set_udata(Stream, AOAInterfaceInfo); +} + +void AOA_Host_CreateBlockingStream(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo, + FILE* const Stream) +{ + *Stream = (FILE)FDEV_SETUP_STREAM(AOA_Host_putchar, AOA_Host_getchar_Blocking, _FDEV_SETUP_RW); + fdev_set_udata(Stream, AOAInterfaceInfo); +} + +static int AOA_Host_putchar(char c, + FILE* Stream) +{ + return AOA_Host_SendByte((USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t*)fdev_get_udata(Stream), c) ? _FDEV_ERR : 0; +} + +static int AOA_Host_getchar(FILE* Stream) +{ + int16_t ReceivedByte = AOA_Host_ReceiveByte((USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t*)fdev_get_udata(Stream)); + + if (ReceivedByte < 0) + return _FDEV_EOF; + + return ReceivedByte; +} + +static int AOA_Host_getchar_Blocking(FILE* Stream) +{ + int16_t ReceivedByte; + + while ((ReceivedByte = AOA_Host_ReceiveByte((USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t*)fdev_get_udata(Stream))) < 0) + { + if (USB_HostState == HOST_STATE_Unattached) + return _FDEV_EOF; + + AOA_Host_USBTask((USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t*)fdev_get_udata(Stream)); + USB_USBTask(); + } + + return ReceivedByte; +} +#endif + +#endif + + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AndroidAccessoryClassHost.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AndroidAccessoryClassHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f4f04e445a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AndroidAccessoryClassHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,314 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Host mode driver for the library USB Android Open Accessory Class driver. + * + * Host mode driver for the library USB Android Open Accessory Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassAOA + * \defgroup Group_USBClassAndroidAccessoryHost Android Open Accessory Class Host Mode Driver + * + * \section Sec_USBClassAndroidAccessoryHost_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AndroidAccessoryClassHost.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassAndroidAccessoryHost_ModDescription Module Description + * Host Mode USB Class driver framework interface, for the Android Open Accessory USB Class driver. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __AOA_CLASS_HOST_H__ +#define __AOA_CLASS_HOST_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../USB.h" + #include "../Common/AndroidAccessoryClassCommon.h" + + #include <stdio.h> + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_AOA_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Error code for some Android Open Accessory Host functions, indicating a logical (and not hardware) error. */ + #define AOA_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED 0x80 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief Android Open Accessory Class Host Mode Configuration and State Structure. + * + * Class state structure. An instance of this structure should be made within the user application, + * and passed to each of the Android Open Accessory class driver functions as the \c AOAInterfaceInfo + * parameter. This stores each Android Open Accessory interface's configuration and state information. + */ + typedef struct + { + struct + { + USB_Pipe_Table_t DataINPipe; /**< Data IN Pipe configuration table. */ + USB_Pipe_Table_t DataOUTPipe; /**< Data OUT Pipe configuration table. */ + + char* PropertyStrings[AOA_STRING_TOTAL_STRINGS]; /**< Android Accessory property strings, sent to identify the accessory when the + * Android device is switched into Open Accessory mode. */ + } Config; /**< Config data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>must</b> be set or the interface will fail to enumerate and operate correctly. + */ + struct + { + bool IsActive; /**< Indicates if the current interface instance is connected to an attached device, valid + * after \ref AOA_Host_ConfigurePipes() is called and the Host state machine is in the + * Configured state. + */ + uint8_t InterfaceNumber; /**< Interface index of the AOA interface within the attached device. */ + } State; /**< State data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>may</b> be set to initial values, but may also be ignored to default to sane values when + * the interface is enumerated. + */ + } USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t; + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible error codes returned by the \ref AOA_Host_ConfigurePipes() function. */ + enum AOA_Host_EnumerationFailure_ErrorCodes_t + { + AOA_ENUMERROR_NoError = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully. */ + AOA_ENUMERROR_InvalidConfigDescriptor = 1, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor. */ + AOA_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 2, /**< A compatible Android Open Accessory interface was not found in the device's Configuration Descriptor. */ + AOA_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed = 3, /**< One or more pipes for the specified interface could not be configured correctly. */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** General management task for a given Android Open Accessory host class interface, required for the correct operation of the interface. + * This should be called frequently in the main program loop, before the master USB management task \ref USB_USBTask(). + * + * \param[in,out] AOAInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Android Open Accessory Class host configuration and state. + */ + void AOA_Host_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Validates a device descriptor, to check if the device is a valid Android device, and if it is currently in Android Open Accessory mode. + * + * \param[in,out] AOAInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an AOA Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] DeviceDescriptor Pointer a buffer containing the attached device's Device Descriptor. + * \param[out] NeedModeSwitch Pointer to a boolean where the mode switch requirement of the attached device is to be stored. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the attached device is a valid Android device, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool AOA_Host_ValidateAccessoryDevice(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo, + const USB_Descriptor_Device_t* const DeviceDescriptor, + bool* const NeedModeSwitch) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /** Host interface configuration routine, to configure a given Android Open Accessory host interface instance using the Configuration + * Descriptor read from an attached USB device. This function automatically updates the given Android Open Accessory Host instance's + * state values and configures the pipes required to communicate with the interface if it is found within the device. This should be + * called once after the stack has enumerated the attached device, while the host state machine is in the Addressed state. + * + * \param[in,out] AOAInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an AOA Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] ConfigDescriptorSize Length of the attached device's Configuration Descriptor. + * \param[in] ConfigDescriptorData Pointer to a buffer containing the attached device's Configuration Descriptor. + * + * \return A value from the \ref AOA_Host_EnumerationFailure_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t AOA_Host_ConfigurePipes(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo, + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize, + void* ConfigDescriptorData) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /** Starts Accessory Mode in the attached Android device. This function will validate the device's Android Open Accessory protocol + * version, send the configured property strings, and request a switch to Android Open Accessory mode. + * + * \param[in,out] AOAInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an AOA Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum, or \ref AOA_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED if a logical error occurred.. + */ + uint8_t AOA_Host_StartAccessoryMode(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sends a given data buffer to the attached USB device, if connected. If a device is not connected when the function is + * called, the data will be discarded. Bytes will be queued for transmission to the device until either the pipe bank + * becomes full, or the \ref AOA_Host_Flush() function is called to flush the pending data to the device. This allows for + * multiple bytes to be packed into a single pipe packet, increasing data throughput. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] AOAInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a AOA Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to a buffer containing the data to send to the device. + * \param[in] Length Length of the data to send to the device. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t AOA_Host_SendData(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo, + const void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sends a given null-terminated string to the attached USB device, if connected. If a device is not connected when the + * function is called, the string is discarded. Bytes will be queued for transmission to the device until either the pipe + * bank becomes full, or the \ref AOA_Host_Flush() function is called to flush the pending data to the device. This allows + * for multiple bytes to be packed into a single pipe packet, increasing data throughput. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] AOAInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a AOA Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] String Pointer to the null terminated string to send to the device. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t AOA_Host_SendString(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo, + const char* const String) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Sends a given byte to the attached USB device, if connected. If a device is not connected when the function is called, the + * byte is discarded. Bytes will be queued for transmission to the device until either the pipe bank becomes full, or the + * \ref AOA_Host_Flush() function is called to flush the pending data to the host. This allows for multiple bytes to be + * packed into a single pipe packet, increasing data throughput. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] AOAInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a AOA Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] Data Byte of data to send to the device. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t AOA_Host_SendByte(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t Data) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Determines the number of bytes received by the AOA interface from the device, waiting to be read. This indicates the number + * of bytes in the IN pipe bank only, and thus the number of calls to \ref AOA_Host_ReceiveByte() which are guaranteed to succeed + * immediately. If multiple bytes are to be received, they should be buffered by the user application, as the pipe bank will not be + * released back to the USB controller until all bytes are read. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] AOAInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a AOA Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return Total number of buffered bytes received from the device. + */ + uint16_t AOA_Host_BytesReceived(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads a byte of data from the device. If no data is waiting to be read of if a USB device is not connected, the function + * returns a negative value. The \ref AOA_Host_BytesReceived() function may be queried in advance to determine how many bytes + * are currently buffered in the AOA interface's data receive pipe. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] AOAInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a AOA Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return Next received byte from the device, or a negative value if no data received. + */ + int16_t AOA_Host_ReceiveByte(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Flushes any data waiting to be sent, ensuring that the send buffer is cleared. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] AOAInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a AOA Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t AOA_Host_Flush(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Creates a standard character stream for the given AOA Device instance so that it can be used with all the regular + * functions in the standard \c <stdio.h> library that accept a \c FILE stream as a destination (e.g. \c fprintf). The created + * stream is bidirectional and can be used for both input and output functions. + * + * Reading data from this stream is non-blocking, i.e. in most instances, complete strings cannot be read in by a single + * fetch, as the endpoint will not be ready at some point in the transmission, aborting the transfer. However, this may + * be used when the read data is processed byte-per-bye (via \c getc()) or when the user application will implement its own + * line buffering. + * + * \note The created stream can be given as \c stdout if desired to direct the standard output from all \c <stdio.h> functions + * to the given AOA interface. + * \n\n + * + * \note This function is not available on all microcontroller architectures. + * + * \param[in,out] AOAInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a AOA Class configuration and state. + * \param[in,out] Stream Pointer to a FILE structure where the created stream should be placed. + */ + void AOA_Host_CreateStream(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo, + FILE* const Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Identical to \ref AOA_Host_CreateStream(), except that reads are blocking until the calling stream function terminates + * the transfer. While blocking, the USB and AOA service tasks are called repeatedly to maintain USB communications. + * + * \note This function is not available on all microcontroller architectures. + * + * \param[in,out] AOAInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a AOA Class configuration and state. + * \param[in,out] Stream Pointer to a FILE structure where the created stream should be placed. + */ + void AOA_Host_CreateBlockingStream(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo, + FILE* const Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_ANDROIDACCESSORY_HOST_C) + #if defined(FDEV_SETUP_STREAM) + static int AOA_Host_putchar(char c, + FILE* Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + static int AOA_Host_getchar(FILE* Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static int AOA_Host_getchar_Blocking(FILE* Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + #endif + + static uint8_t AOA_Host_GetAccessoryProtocol(uint16_t* const Protocol) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static uint8_t AOA_Host_SendPropertyString(USB_ClassInfo_AOA_Host_t* const AOAInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t StringIndex) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + static uint8_t DCOMP_AOA_Host_NextAndroidAccessoryInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static uint8_t DCOMP_AOA_Host_NextInterfaceBulkEndpoint(void* const CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + #endif + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AudioClassHost.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AudioClassHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9f1a6dc2c8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AudioClassHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,223 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../../Core/USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_AUDIO_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_AUDIO_HOST_C +#include "AudioClassHost.h" + +uint8_t Audio_Host_ConfigurePipes(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize, + void* ConfigDescriptorData) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* AudioControlInterface = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* AudioStreamingInterface = NULL; + + memset(&AudioInterfaceInfo->State, 0x00, sizeof(AudioInterfaceInfo->State)); + + if (DESCRIPTOR_TYPE(ConfigDescriptorData) != DTYPE_Configuration) + return AUDIO_ENUMERROR_InvalidConfigDescriptor; + + while ((AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address && !(DataINEndpoint)) || + (AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address && !(DataOUTEndpoint))) + { + if (!(AudioControlInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_Audio_Host_NextAudioInterfaceDataEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + if (!(AudioControlInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_Audio_Host_NextAudioStreamInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_Audio_Host_NextAudioControlInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + return AUDIO_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + AudioControlInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_Audio_Host_NextAudioStreamInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + return AUDIO_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + } + + AudioStreamingInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + DataINEndpoint = NULL; + DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + + continue; + } + + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + else + DataOUTEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + + AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize); + AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.EndpointAddress = DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS; + AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Banks = 2; + + AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointSize); + AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.EndpointAddress = DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS; + AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Banks = 2; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe, 1))) + return AUDIO_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe, 1))) + return AUDIO_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + AudioInterfaceInfo->State.ControlInterfaceNumber = AudioControlInterface->InterfaceNumber; + AudioInterfaceInfo->State.StreamingInterfaceNumber = AudioStreamingInterface->InterfaceNumber; + AudioInterfaceInfo->State.EnabledStreamingAltIndex = AudioStreamingInterface->AlternateSetting; + AudioInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive = true; + + return AUDIO_ENUMERROR_NoError; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_Audio_Host_NextAudioControlInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + if ((Interface->Class == AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == AUDIO_CSCP_ControlSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == AUDIO_CSCP_ControlProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_Audio_Host_NextAudioStreamInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + if ((Interface->Class == AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == AUDIO_CSCP_AudioStreamingSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == AUDIO_CSCP_StreamingProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_Audio_Host_NextAudioInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* Endpoint = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + if ((Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK) == EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +uint8_t Audio_Host_StartStopStreaming(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const bool EnableStreaming) +{ + if (!(AudioInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_DeviceDisconnected; + + return USB_Host_SetInterfaceAltSetting(AudioInterfaceInfo->State.StreamingInterfaceNumber, + EnableStreaming ? AudioInterfaceInfo->State.EnabledStreamingAltIndex : 0); +} + +uint8_t Audio_Host_GetSetEndpointProperty(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t DataPipeIndex, + const uint8_t EndpointProperty, + const uint8_t EndpointControl, + const uint16_t DataLength, + void* const Data) +{ + if (!(AudioInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t RequestType; + uint8_t EndpointAddress; + + if (EndpointProperty & 0x80) + RequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_ENDPOINT); + else + RequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_ENDPOINT); + + Pipe_SelectPipe(DataPipeIndex); + EndpointAddress = Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress(); + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = RequestType, + .bRequest = EndpointProperty, + .wValue = ((uint16_t)EndpointControl << 8), + .wIndex = EndpointAddress, + .wLength = DataLength, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(Data); +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AudioClassHost.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AudioClassHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f1f4207f19 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AudioClassHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,411 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Host mode driver for the library USB Audio 1.0 Class driver. + * + * Host mode driver for the library USB Audio 1.0 Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassAudio + * \defgroup Group_USBClassAudioHost Audio 1.0 Class Host Mode Driver + * + * \section Sec_USBClassAudioHost_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AudioClassHost.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassAudioHost_ModDescription Module Description + * Host Mode USB Class driver framework interface, for the Audio 1.0 USB Class driver. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __AUDIO_CLASS_HOST_H__ +#define __AUDIO_CLASS_HOST_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../USB.h" + #include "../Common/AudioClassCommon.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_AUDIO_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief Audio Class Host Mode Configuration and State Structure. + * + * Class state structure. An instance of this structure should be made within the user application, + * and passed to each of the Audio class driver functions as the \c AudioInterfaceInfo parameter. This + * stores each Audio interface's configuration and state information. + */ + typedef struct + { + struct + { + USB_Pipe_Table_t DataINPipe; /**< Data IN Pipe configuration table. */ + USB_Pipe_Table_t DataOUTPipe; /**< Data OUT Pipe configuration table. */ + } Config; /**< Config data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>must</b> be set or the interface will fail to enumerate and operate correctly. + */ + struct + { + bool IsActive; /**< Indicates if the current interface instance is connected to an attached device, valid + * after \ref Audio_Host_ConfigurePipes() is called and the Host state machine is in the + * Configured state. + */ + uint8_t ControlInterfaceNumber; /**< Interface index of the Audio Control interface within the attached device. */ + uint8_t StreamingInterfaceNumber; /**< Interface index of the Audio Streaming interface within the attached device. */ + + uint8_t EnabledStreamingAltIndex; /**< Alternative setting index of the Audio Streaming interface when the stream is enabled. */ + } State; /**< State data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>may</b> be set to initial values, but may also be ignored to default to sane values when + * the interface is enumerated. + */ + } USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t; + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible error codes returned by the \ref Audio_Host_ConfigurePipes() function. */ + enum AUDIO_Host_EnumerationFailure_ErrorCodes_t + { + AUDIO_ENUMERROR_NoError = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully. */ + AUDIO_ENUMERROR_InvalidConfigDescriptor = 1, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor. */ + AUDIO_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 2, /**< A compatible AUDIO interface was not found in the device's Configuration Descriptor. */ + AUDIO_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed = 3, /**< One or more pipes for the specified interface could not be configured correctly. */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Host interface configuration routine, to configure a given Audio host interface instance using the Configuration + * Descriptor read from an attached USB device. This function automatically updates the given Audio Host instance's + * state values and configures the pipes required to communicate with the interface if it is found within the + * device. This should be called once after the stack has enumerated the attached device, while the host state + * machine is in the Addressed state. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] ConfigDescriptorSize Length of the attached device's Configuration Descriptor. + * \param[in] ConfigDescriptorData Pointer to a buffer containing the attached device's Configuration Descriptor. + * + * \return A value from the \ref AUDIO_Host_EnumerationFailure_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Audio_Host_ConfigurePipes(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize, + void* ConfigDescriptorData) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /** Starts or stops the audio streaming for the given configured Audio Host interface, allowing for audio samples to be + * send and/or received. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] EnableStreaming Boolean true to enable streaming of the specified interface, \c false to disable + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Audio_Host_StartStopStreaming(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const bool EnableStreaming) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Gets or sets the specified property of a streaming audio class endpoint that is bound to a pipe in the given + * class instance. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] DataPipeIndex Index of the data pipe whose bound endpoint is to be altered. + * \param[in] EndpointProperty Property of the endpoint to get or set, a value from \ref Audio_ClassRequests_t. + * \param[in] EndpointControl Parameter of the endpoint to get or set, a value from \ref Audio_EndpointControls_t. + * \param[in,out] DataLength For SET operations, the length of the parameter data to set. For GET operations, the maximum + * length of the retrieved data. + * \param[in,out] Data Pointer to a location where the parameter data is stored for SET operations, or where + * the retrieved data is to be stored for GET operations. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Audio_Host_GetSetEndpointProperty(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t DataPipeIndex, + const uint8_t EndpointProperty, + const uint8_t EndpointControl, + const uint16_t DataLength, + void* const Data) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(6); + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** General management task for a given Audio host class interface, required for the correct operation of + * the interface. This should be called frequently in the main program loop, before the master USB management task + * \ref USB_USBTask(). + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class host configuration and state. + */ + static inline void Audio_Host_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Audio_Host_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + { + (void)AudioInterfaceInfo; + } + + /** Determines if the given audio interface is ready for a sample to be read from it, and selects the streaming + * IN pipe ready for reading. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the given Audio interface has a sample to be read, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Audio_Host_IsSampleReceived(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Audio_Host_IsSampleReceived(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + { + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(AudioInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return false; + + bool SampleReceived = false; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + SampleReceived = Pipe_IsINReceived(); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return SampleReceived; + } + + /** Determines if the given audio interface is ready to accept the next sample to be written to it, and selects + * the streaming OUT pipe ready for writing. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the given Audio interface is ready to accept the next sample, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Audio_Host_IsReadyForNextSample(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Audio_Host_IsReadyForNextSample(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + { + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(AudioInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return false; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(AudioInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + return Pipe_IsOUTReady(); + } + + /** Reads the next 8-bit audio sample from the current audio interface. + * + * \pre This should be preceded immediately by a call to the \ref Audio_Host_IsSampleReceived() function to ensure + * that the correct pipe is selected and ready for data. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Signed 8-bit audio sample from the audio interface. + */ + static inline int8_t Audio_Host_ReadSample8(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline int8_t Audio_Host_ReadSample8(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + { + int8_t Sample; + + (void)AudioInterfaceInfo; + + Sample = Pipe_Read_8(); + + if (!(Pipe_BytesInPipe())) + { + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + Pipe_ClearIN(); + Pipe_Freeze(); + } + + return Sample; + } + + /** Reads the next 16-bit audio sample from the current audio interface. + * + * \pre This should be preceded immediately by a call to the \ref Audio_Host_IsSampleReceived() function to ensure + * that the correct pipe is selected and ready for data. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Signed 16-bit audio sample from the audio interface. + */ + static inline int16_t Audio_Host_ReadSample16(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline int16_t Audio_Host_ReadSample16(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + { + int16_t Sample; + + (void)AudioInterfaceInfo; + + Sample = (int16_t)Pipe_Read_16_LE(); + + if (!(Pipe_BytesInPipe())) + { + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + Pipe_ClearIN(); + Pipe_Freeze(); + } + + return Sample; + } + + /** Reads the next 24-bit audio sample from the current audio interface. + * + * \pre This should be preceded immediately by a call to the \ref Audio_Host_IsSampleReceived() function to ensure + * that the correct pipe is selected and ready for data. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * + * \return Signed 24-bit audio sample from the audio interface. + */ + static inline int32_t Audio_Host_ReadSample24(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline int32_t Audio_Host_ReadSample24(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo) + { + int32_t Sample; + + (void)AudioInterfaceInfo; + + Sample = (((uint32_t)Pipe_Read_8() << 16) | Pipe_Read_16_LE()); + + if (!(Pipe_BytesInPipe())) + { + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + Pipe_ClearIN(); + Pipe_Freeze(); + } + + return Sample; + } + + /** Writes the next 8-bit audio sample to the current audio interface. + * + * \pre This should be preceded immediately by a call to the \ref Audio_Host_IsReadyForNextSample() function to + * ensure that the correct pipe is selected and ready for data. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] Sample Signed 8-bit audio sample. + */ + static inline void Audio_Host_WriteSample8(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const int8_t Sample) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Audio_Host_WriteSample8(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const int8_t Sample) + { + (void)AudioInterfaceInfo; + + Pipe_Write_8(Sample); + + if (!(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + Pipe_WaitUntilReady(); + Pipe_Freeze(); + } + } + + /** Writes the next 16-bit audio sample to the current audio interface. + * + * \pre This should be preceded immediately by a call to the \ref Audio_Host_IsReadyForNextSample() function to + * ensure that the correct pipe is selected and ready for data. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] Sample Signed 16-bit audio sample. + */ + static inline void Audio_Host_WriteSample16(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const int16_t Sample) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Audio_Host_WriteSample16(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const int16_t Sample) + { + (void)AudioInterfaceInfo; + + Pipe_Write_16_LE(Sample); + + if (!(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + Pipe_WaitUntilReady(); + Pipe_Freeze(); + } + } + + /** Writes the next 24-bit audio sample to the current audio interface. + * + * \pre This should be preceded immediately by a call to the \ref Audio_Host_IsReadyForNextSample() function to + * ensure that the correct pipe is selected and ready for data. + * + * \param[in,out] AudioInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Audio Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] Sample Signed 24-bit audio sample. + */ + static inline void Audio_Host_WriteSample24(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const int32_t Sample) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Audio_Host_WriteSample24(USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Host_t* const AudioInterfaceInfo, + const int32_t Sample) + { + (void)AudioInterfaceInfo; + + Pipe_Write_16_LE(Sample); + Pipe_Write_8(Sample >> 16); + + if (!(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + Pipe_WaitUntilReady(); + Pipe_Freeze(); + } + } + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_AUDIO_HOST_C) + static uint8_t DCOMP_Audio_Host_NextAudioControlInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static uint8_t DCOMP_Audio_Host_NextAudioStreamInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static uint8_t DCOMP_Audio_Host_NextAudioInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + #endif + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/CDCClassHost.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/CDCClassHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..af9ed96e24 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/CDCClassHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,512 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../../Core/USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_CDC_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_CDC_HOST_C +#include "CDCClassHost.h" + +uint8_t CDC_Host_ConfigurePipes(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize, + void* ConfigDescriptorData) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* NotificationEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* CDCControlInterface = NULL; + + memset(&CDCInterfaceInfo->State, 0x00, sizeof(CDCInterfaceInfo->State)); + + if (DESCRIPTOR_TYPE(ConfigDescriptorData) != DTYPE_Configuration) + return CDC_ENUMERROR_InvalidConfigDescriptor; + + while (!(DataINEndpoint) || !(DataOUTEndpoint) || !(NotificationEndpoint)) + { + if (!(CDCControlInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_CDC_Host_NextCDCInterfaceEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + if (NotificationEndpoint) + { + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_CDC_Host_NextCDCDataInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + return CDC_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + DataINEndpoint = NULL; + DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + } + else + { + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_CDC_Host_NextCDCControlInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + return CDC_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + CDCControlInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + NotificationEndpoint = NULL; + } + + continue; + } + + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + { + if ((EndpointData->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK) == EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT) + NotificationEndpoint = EndpointData; + else + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + else + { + DataOUTEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + } + + CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize); + CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.EndpointAddress = DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + + CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointSize); + CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.EndpointAddress = DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + + CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.NotificationPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(NotificationEndpoint->EndpointSize); + CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.NotificationPipe.EndpointAddress = NotificationEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.NotificationPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe, 1))) + return CDC_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe, 1))) + return CDC_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.NotificationPipe, 1))) + return CDC_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + CDCInterfaceInfo->State.ControlInterfaceNumber = CDCControlInterface->InterfaceNumber; + CDCInterfaceInfo->State.ControlLineStates.HostToDevice = (CDC_CONTROL_LINE_OUT_RTS | CDC_CONTROL_LINE_OUT_DTR); + CDCInterfaceInfo->State.ControlLineStates.DeviceToHost = (CDC_CONTROL_LINE_IN_DCD | CDC_CONTROL_LINE_IN_DSR); + CDCInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive = true; + + return CDC_ENUMERROR_NoError; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_CDC_Host_NextCDCControlInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + if ((Interface->Class == CDC_CSCP_CDCClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_CDC_Host_NextCDCDataInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + if ((Interface->Class == CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_CDC_Host_NextCDCInterfaceEndpoint(void* const CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* Endpoint = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + uint8_t EndpointType = (Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK); + + if (((EndpointType == EP_TYPE_BULK) || (EndpointType == EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT)) && + !(Pipe_IsEndpointBound(Endpoint->EndpointAddress))) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +void CDC_Host_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.NotificationPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + { + USB_Request_Header_t Notification; + Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(&Notification, sizeof(USB_Request_Header_t), NULL); + + if ((Notification.bRequest == CDC_NOTIF_SerialState) && + (Notification.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE))) + { + Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(&CDCInterfaceInfo->State.ControlLineStates.DeviceToHost, + sizeof(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.ControlLineStates.DeviceToHost), + NULL); + + Pipe_ClearIN(); + + EVENT_CDC_Host_ControLineStateChanged(CDCInterfaceInfo); + } + else + { + Pipe_ClearIN(); + } + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + #if !defined(NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH) + CDC_Host_Flush(CDCInterfaceInfo); + #endif +} + +uint8_t CDC_Host_SetLineEncoding(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = CDC_REQ_SetLineEncoding, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = CDCInterfaceInfo->State.ControlInterfaceNumber, + .wLength = sizeof(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding), + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(&CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding); +} + +uint8_t CDC_Host_SendControlLineStateChange(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = CDC_REQ_SetControlLineState, + .wValue = CDCInterfaceInfo->State.ControlLineStates.HostToDevice, + .wIndex = CDCInterfaceInfo->State.ControlInterfaceNumber, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(NULL); +} + +uint8_t CDC_Host_SendBreak(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t Duration) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = CDC_REQ_SendBreak, + .wValue = Duration, + .wIndex = CDCInterfaceInfo->State.ControlInterfaceNumber, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(NULL); +} + +uint8_t CDC_Host_SendData(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(Buffer, Length, NULL); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return ErrorCode; +} + +uint8_t CDC_Host_SendData_P(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_PStream_LE(Buffer, Length, NULL); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return ErrorCode; +} + +uint8_t CDC_Host_SendString(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const char* const String) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(String, strlen(String), NULL); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return ErrorCode; +} + +uint8_t CDC_Host_SendString_P(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const char* const String) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_PStream_LE(String, strlen_P(String), NULL); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return ErrorCode; +} + +uint8_t CDC_Host_SendByte(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t Data) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (!(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady()) != PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + } + + Pipe_Write_8(Data); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError; +} + +uint16_t CDC_Host_BytesReceived(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return 0; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + { + if (!(Pipe_BytesInPipe())) + { + Pipe_ClearIN(); + Pipe_Freeze(); + return 0; + } + else + { + Pipe_Freeze(); + return Pipe_BytesInPipe(); + } + } + else + { + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return 0; + } +} + +int16_t CDC_Host_ReceiveByte(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return -1; + + int16_t ReceivedByte = -1; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + { + if (Pipe_BytesInPipe()) + ReceivedByte = Pipe_Read_8(); + + if (!(Pipe_BytesInPipe())) + Pipe_ClearIN(); + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return ReceivedByte; +} + +uint8_t CDC_Host_Flush(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(CDCInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (!(Pipe_BytesInPipe())) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError; + + bool BankFull = !(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed()); + + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + if (BankFull) + { + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady()) != PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError; +} + +#if defined(FDEV_SETUP_STREAM) +void CDC_Host_CreateStream(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + FILE* const Stream) +{ + *Stream = (FILE)FDEV_SETUP_STREAM(CDC_Host_putchar, CDC_Host_getchar, _FDEV_SETUP_RW); + fdev_set_udata(Stream, CDCInterfaceInfo); +} + +void CDC_Host_CreateBlockingStream(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + FILE* const Stream) +{ + *Stream = (FILE)FDEV_SETUP_STREAM(CDC_Host_putchar, CDC_Host_getchar_Blocking, _FDEV_SETUP_RW); + fdev_set_udata(Stream, CDCInterfaceInfo); +} + +static int CDC_Host_putchar(char c, + FILE* Stream) +{ + return CDC_Host_SendByte((USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t*)fdev_get_udata(Stream), c) ? _FDEV_ERR : 0; +} + +static int CDC_Host_getchar(FILE* Stream) +{ + int16_t ReceivedByte = CDC_Host_ReceiveByte((USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t*)fdev_get_udata(Stream)); + + if (ReceivedByte < 0) + return _FDEV_EOF; + + return ReceivedByte; +} + +static int CDC_Host_getchar_Blocking(FILE* Stream) +{ + int16_t ReceivedByte; + + while ((ReceivedByte = CDC_Host_ReceiveByte((USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t*)fdev_get_udata(Stream))) < 0) + { + if (USB_HostState == HOST_STATE_Unattached) + return _FDEV_EOF; + + CDC_Host_USBTask((USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t*)fdev_get_udata(Stream)); + USB_USBTask(); + } + + return ReceivedByte; +} +#endif + +void CDC_Host_Event_Stub(void) +{ + +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/CDCClassHost.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/CDCClassHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..86ce6def38 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/CDCClassHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,385 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Host mode driver for the library USB CDC Class driver. + * + * Host mode driver for the library USB CDC Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassCDC + * \defgroup Group_USBClassCDCHost CDC Class Host Mode Driver + * + * \section Sec_USBClassCDCHost_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/CDCClassHost.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassCDCHost_ModDescription Module Description + * Host Mode USB Class driver framework interface, for the CDC USB Class driver. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __CDC_CLASS_HOST_H__ +#define __CDC_CLASS_HOST_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../USB.h" + #include "../Common/CDCClassCommon.h" + + #include <stdio.h> + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_CDC_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief CDC Class Host Mode Configuration and State Structure. + * + * Class state structure. An instance of this structure should be made within the user application, + * and passed to each of the CDC class driver functions as the \c CDCInterfaceInfo parameter. This + * stores each CDC interface's configuration and state information. + */ + typedef struct + { + struct + { + USB_Pipe_Table_t DataINPipe; /**< Data IN Pipe configuration table. */ + USB_Pipe_Table_t DataOUTPipe; /**< Data OUT Pipe configuration table. */ + USB_Pipe_Table_t NotificationPipe; /**< Notification IN Pipe configuration table. */ + } Config; /**< Config data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>must</b> be set or the interface will fail to enumerate and operate correctly. + */ + struct + { + bool IsActive; /**< Indicates if the current interface instance is connected to an attached device, valid + * after \ref CDC_Host_ConfigurePipes() is called and the Host state machine is in the + * Configured state. + */ + uint8_t ControlInterfaceNumber; /**< Interface index of the CDC-ACM control interface within the attached device. */ + + struct + { + uint16_t HostToDevice; /**< Control line states from the host to device, as a set of \c CDC_CONTROL_LINE_OUT_* + * masks - to notify the device of changes to these values, call the + * \ref CDC_Host_SendControlLineStateChange() function. + */ + uint16_t DeviceToHost; /**< Control line states from the device to host, as a set of \c CDC_CONTROL_LINE_IN_* + * masks. This value is updated each time \ref CDC_Host_USBTask() is called. + */ + } ControlLineStates; /**< Current states of the virtual serial port's control lines between the device and host. */ + + CDC_LineEncoding_t LineEncoding; /**< Line encoding used in the virtual serial port, for the device's information. + * This is generally only used if the virtual serial port data is to be + * reconstructed on a physical UART. When set by the host application, the + * \ref CDC_Host_SetLineEncoding() function must be called to push the changes + * to the device. + */ + } State; /**< State data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>may</b> be set to initial values, but may also be ignored to default to sane values when + * the interface is enumerated. + */ + } USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t; + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible error codes returned by the \ref CDC_Host_ConfigurePipes() function. */ + enum CDC_Host_EnumerationFailure_ErrorCodes_t + { + CDC_ENUMERROR_NoError = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully. */ + CDC_ENUMERROR_InvalidConfigDescriptor = 1, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor. */ + CDC_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 2, /**< A compatible CDC interface was not found in the device's Configuration Descriptor. */ + CDC_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed = 3, /**< One or more pipes for the specified interface could not be configured correctly. */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** General management task for a given CDC host class interface, required for the correct operation of the interface. This should + * be called frequently in the main program loop, before the master USB management task \ref USB_USBTask(). + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an CDC Class host configuration and state. + */ + void CDC_Host_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Host interface configuration routine, to configure a given CDC host interface instance using the Configuration + * Descriptor read from an attached USB device. This function automatically updates the given CDC Host instance's + * state values and configures the pipes required to communicate with the interface if it is found within the device. + * This should be called once after the stack has enumerated the attached device, while the host state machine is in + * the Addressed state. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an CDC Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] ConfigDescriptorSize Length of the attached device's Configuration Descriptor. + * \param[in] ConfigDescriptorData Pointer to a buffer containing the attached device's Configuration Descriptor. + * + * \return A value from the \ref CDC_Host_EnumerationFailure_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t CDC_Host_ConfigurePipes(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize, + void* ConfigDescriptorData) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /** Sets the line encoding for the attached device's virtual serial port. This should be called when the \c LineEncoding + * values of the interface have been changed to push the new settings to the USB device. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t CDC_Host_SetLineEncoding(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sends a Serial Control Line State Change notification to the device. This should be called when the virtual serial + * control lines (DTR, RTS, etc.) have changed states. Line states persist until they are cleared via a second + * notification. This should be called each time the CDC class driver's \c ControlLineStates.HostToDevice value is updated + * to push the new states to the USB device. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t CDC_Host_SendControlLineStateChange(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sends a Send Break request to the device. This is generally used to separate data or to indicate a special condition + * to the receiving device. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] Duration Duration of the break, in milliseconds. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t CDC_Host_SendBreak(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t Duration) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sends a given data buffer to the attached USB device, if connected. If a device is not connected when the function is + * called, the data will be discarded. Bytes will be queued for transmission to the device until either the pipe bank + * becomes full, or the \ref CDC_Host_Flush() function is called to flush the pending data to the device. This allows for + * multiple bytes to be packed into a single pipe packet, increasing data throughput. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to a buffer containing the data to send to the device. + * \param[in] Length Length of the data to send to the device. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t CDC_Host_SendData(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sends a given data buffer from PROGMEM space to the attached USB device, if connected. If a device is not connected when the + * function is called, the string is discarded. Bytes will be queued for transmission to the host until either the pipe + * bank becomes full, or the \ref CDC_Host_Flush() function is called to flush the pending data to the device. This allows + * for multiple bytes to be packed into a single pipe packet, increasing data throughput. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to a buffer containing the data to send to the device. + * \param[in] Length Length of the data to send to the host. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t CDC_Host_SendData_P(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const void* const Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sends a given null-terminated string to the attached USB device, if connected. If a device is not connected when the + * function is called, the string is discarded. Bytes will be queued for transmission to the device until either the pipe + * bank becomes full, or the \ref CDC_Host_Flush() function is called to flush the pending data to the device. This allows + * for multiple bytes to be packed into a single pipe packet, increasing data throughput. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] String Pointer to the null terminated string to send to the device. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t CDC_Host_SendString(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const char* const String) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Sends a given null terminated string from PROGMEM space to the attached USB device, if connected. If a device is not connected + * when the function is called, the string is discarded. Bytes will be queued for transmission to the device until either + * the pipe bank becomes full, or the \ref CDC_Host_Flush() function is called to flush the pending data to + * the device. This allows for multiple bytes to be packed into a single pipe packet, increasing data throughput. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or + * the call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] String Pointer to the null terminated string to send to the host. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t CDC_Host_SendString_P(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const char* const String) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Sends a given byte to the attached USB device, if connected. If a device is not connected when the function is called, the + * byte is discarded. Bytes will be queued for transmission to the device until either the pipe bank becomes full, or the + * \ref CDC_Host_Flush() function is called to flush the pending data to the host. This allows for multiple bytes to be + * packed into a single pipe packet, increasing data throughput. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] Data Byte of data to send to the device. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t CDC_Host_SendByte(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t Data) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Determines the number of bytes received by the CDC interface from the device, waiting to be read. This indicates the number + * of bytes in the IN pipe bank only, and thus the number of calls to \ref CDC_Host_ReceiveByte() which are guaranteed to succeed + * immediately. If multiple bytes are to be received, they should be buffered by the user application, as the pipe bank will not be + * released back to the USB controller until all bytes are read. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return Total number of buffered bytes received from the device. + */ + uint16_t CDC_Host_BytesReceived(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads a byte of data from the device. If no data is waiting to be read of if a USB device is not connected, the function + * returns a negative value. The \ref CDC_Host_BytesReceived() function may be queried in advance to determine how many bytes + * are currently buffered in the CDC interface's data receive pipe. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return Next received byte from the device, or a negative value if no data received. + */ + int16_t CDC_Host_ReceiveByte(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Flushes any data waiting to be sent, ensuring that the send buffer is cleared. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t CDC_Host_Flush(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + #if defined(FDEV_SETUP_STREAM) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Creates a standard character stream for the given CDC Device instance so that it can be used with all the regular + * functions in the standard \c <stdio.h> library that accept a \c FILE stream as a destination (e.g. \c fprintf). The created + * stream is bidirectional and can be used for both input and output functions. + * + * Reading data from this stream is non-blocking, i.e. in most instances, complete strings cannot be read in by a single + * fetch, as the endpoint will not be ready at some point in the transmission, aborting the transfer. However, this may + * be used when the read data is processed byte-per-bye (via \c getc()) or when the user application will implement its own + * line buffering. + * + * \note The created stream can be given as \c stdout if desired to direct the standard output from all \c <stdio.h> functions + * to the given CDC interface. + * \n\n + * + * \note This function is not available on all microcontroller architectures. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class configuration and state. + * \param[in,out] Stream Pointer to a FILE structure where the created stream should be placed. + */ + void CDC_Host_CreateStream(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + FILE* const Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Identical to \ref CDC_Host_CreateStream(), except that reads are blocking until the calling stream function terminates + * the transfer. While blocking, the USB and CDC service tasks are called repeatedly to maintain USB communications. + * + * \note This function is not available on all microcontroller architectures. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class configuration and state. + * \param[in,out] Stream Pointer to a FILE structure where the created stream should be placed. + */ + void CDC_Host_CreateBlockingStream(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo, + FILE* const Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + #endif + + /** CDC class driver event for a control line state change on a CDC host interface. This event fires each time the device notifies + * the host of a control line state change (containing the virtual serial control line states, such as DCD) and may be hooked in the + * user program by declaring a handler function with the same name and parameters listed here. The new control line states + * are available in the \c ControlLineStates.DeviceToHost value inside the CDC host interface structure passed as a parameter, set as + * a mask of \c CDC_CONTROL_LINE_IN_* masks. + * + * \param[in,out] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a CDC Class host configuration and state. + */ + void EVENT_CDC_Host_ControLineStateChanged(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_CDC_HOST_C) + #if defined(FDEV_SETUP_STREAM) + static int CDC_Host_putchar(char c, + FILE* Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + static int CDC_Host_getchar(FILE* Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static int CDC_Host_getchar_Blocking(FILE* Stream) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + #endif + + void CDC_Host_Event_Stub(void) ATTR_CONST; + + void EVENT_CDC_Host_ControLineStateChanged(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Host_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) + ATTR_WEAK ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALIAS(CDC_Host_Event_Stub); + + static uint8_t DCOMP_CDC_Host_NextCDCControlInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static uint8_t DCOMP_CDC_Host_NextCDCDataInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static uint8_t DCOMP_CDC_Host_NextCDCInterfaceEndpoint(void* const CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + #endif + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/HIDClassHost.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/HIDClassHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..32591ffd74 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/HIDClassHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,399 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../../Core/USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_HID_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_HID_HOST_C +#include "HIDClassHost.h" + +uint8_t HID_Host_ConfigurePipes(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize, + void* ConfigDescriptorData) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* HIDInterface = NULL; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t* HIDDescriptor = NULL; + + memset(&HIDInterfaceInfo->State, 0x00, sizeof(HIDInterfaceInfo->State)); + + if (DESCRIPTOR_TYPE(ConfigDescriptorData) != DTYPE_Configuration) + return HID_ENUMERROR_InvalidConfigDescriptor; + + while (!(DataINEndpoint) || !(DataOUTEndpoint)) + { + if (!(HIDInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_HID_Host_NextHIDInterfaceEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + if (DataINEndpoint) + break; + + do + { + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_HID_Host_NextHIDInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + return HID_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + HIDInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + } while (HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.HIDInterfaceProtocol && + (HIDInterface->Protocol != HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.HIDInterfaceProtocol)); + + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_HID_Host_NextHIDDescriptor) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + return HID_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + HIDDescriptor = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + + DataINEndpoint = NULL; + DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + + continue; + } + + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + else + DataOUTEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + + HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize); + HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.EndpointAddress = DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe, 1))) + return HID_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + if (DataOUTEndpoint) + { + HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointSize); + HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.EndpointAddress = DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe, 1))) + return HID_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + } + + HIDInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceNumber = HIDInterface->InterfaceNumber; + HIDInterfaceInfo->State.HIDReportSize = LE16_TO_CPU(HIDDescriptor->HIDReportLength); + HIDInterfaceInfo->State.SupportsBootProtocol = (HIDInterface->SubClass != HID_CSCP_NonBootProtocol); + HIDInterfaceInfo->State.LargestReportSize = 8; + HIDInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive = true; + + return HID_ENUMERROR_NoError; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_HID_Host_NextHIDInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + if (Interface->Class == HID_CSCP_HIDClass) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_HID_Host_NextHIDDescriptor(void* const CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == HID_DTYPE_HID) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + else + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_HID_Host_NextHIDInterfaceEndpoint(void* const CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* Endpoint = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + if (!(Pipe_IsEndpointBound(Endpoint->EndpointAddress))) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +#if !defined(HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY) +uint8_t HID_Host_ReceiveReportByID(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + void* Buffer) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = HID_REQ_SetReport, + .wValue = ((HID_REPORT_ITEM_In + 1) << 8) | ReportID, + .wIndex = HIDInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceNumber, + .wLength = USB_GetHIDReportSize(HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.HIDParserData, ReportID, HID_REPORT_ITEM_In), + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(Buffer); +} +#endif + +uint8_t HID_Host_ReceiveReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + void* Buffer) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(HIDInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + uint16_t ReportSize; + uint8_t* BufferPos = Buffer; + +#if !defined(HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY) + if (!(HIDInterfaceInfo->State.UsingBootProtocol)) + { + uint8_t ReportID = 0; + + if (HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.HIDParserData->UsingReportIDs) + { + ReportID = Pipe_Read_8(); + *(BufferPos++) = ReportID; + } + + ReportSize = USB_GetHIDReportSize(HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.HIDParserData, ReportID, HID_REPORT_ITEM_In); + } + else +#endif + { + ReportSize = Pipe_BytesInPipe(); + } + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(BufferPos, ReportSize, NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + Pipe_ClearIN(); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +uint8_t HID_Host_SendReportByID(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, +#if !defined(HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY) + const uint8_t ReportID, +#endif + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t ReportSize) +{ +#if !defined(HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY) + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(HIDInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; + + if (HIDInterfaceInfo->State.DeviceUsesOUTPipe && (ReportType == HID_REPORT_ITEM_Out)) + { + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (ReportID) + Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(&ReportID, sizeof(ReportID), NULL); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(Buffer, ReportSize, NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; + } + else +#endif + { + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = HID_REQ_SetReport, +#if !defined(HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY) + .wValue = ((ReportType + 1) << 8) | ReportID, +#else + .wValue = ((ReportType + 1) << 8), +#endif + .wIndex = HIDInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceNumber, + .wLength = ReportSize, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(Buffer); + } +} + +bool HID_Host_IsReportReceived(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(HIDInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return false; + + bool ReportReceived; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + ReportReceived = Pipe_IsINReceived(); + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return ReportReceived; +} + +uint8_t HID_Host_SetBootProtocol(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if (!(HIDInterfaceInfo->State.SupportsBootProtocol)) + return HID_ERROR_LOGICAL; + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = HID_REQ_SetProtocol, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = HIDInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceNumber, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(NULL)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ErrorCode; + + HIDInterfaceInfo->State.LargestReportSize = 8; + HIDInterfaceInfo->State.UsingBootProtocol = true; + + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; +} + +uint8_t HID_Host_SetIdlePeriod(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint16_t MS) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = HID_REQ_SetIdle, + .wValue = ((MS << 6) & 0xFF00), + .wIndex = HIDInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceNumber, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(NULL); +} + +#if !defined(HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY) +uint8_t HID_Host_SetReportProtocol(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + uint8_t HIDReportData[HIDInterfaceInfo->State.HIDReportSize]; + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = REQ_GetDescriptor, + .wValue = (HID_DTYPE_Report << 8), + .wIndex = HIDInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceNumber, + .wLength = HIDInterfaceInfo->State.HIDReportSize, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(HIDReportData)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ErrorCode; + + if (HIDInterfaceInfo->State.UsingBootProtocol) + { + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = HID_REQ_SetProtocol, + .wValue = 1, + .wIndex = HIDInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceNumber, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(NULL)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ErrorCode; + + HIDInterfaceInfo->State.UsingBootProtocol = false; + } + + if (HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.HIDParserData == NULL) + return HID_ERROR_LOGICAL; + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_ProcessHIDReport(HIDReportData, HIDInterfaceInfo->State.HIDReportSize, + HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.HIDParserData)) != HID_PARSE_Successful) + { + return HID_ERROR_LOGICAL | ErrorCode; + } + + uint16_t LargestReportSizeBits = HIDInterfaceInfo->Config.HIDParserData->LargestReportSizeBits; + HIDInterfaceInfo->State.LargestReportSize = (LargestReportSizeBits >> 3) + ((LargestReportSizeBits & 0x07) != 0); + + return 0; +} +#endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/HIDClassHost.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/HIDClassHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..73b5abb1ba --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/HIDClassHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,313 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Host mode driver for the library USB HID Class driver. + * + * Host mode driver for the library USB HID Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassHID + * \defgroup Group_USBClassHIDHost HID Class Host Mode Driver + * + * \section Sec_USBClassHIDHost_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/HIDClassHost.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassHIDHost_ModDescription Module Description + * Host Mode USB Class driver framework interface, for the HID USB Class driver. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __HID_CLASS_HOST_H__ +#define __HID_CLASS_HOST_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../USB.h" + #include "../Common/HIDClassCommon.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_HID_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Error code for some HID Host functions, indicating a logical (and not hardware) error. */ + #define HID_ERROR_LOGICAL 0x80 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief HID Class Host Mode Configuration and State Structure. + * + * Class state structure. An instance of this structure should be made within the user application, + * and passed to each of the HID class driver functions as the \c HIDInterfaceInfo parameter. This + * stores each HID interface's configuration and state information. + */ + typedef struct + { + struct + { + USB_Pipe_Table_t DataINPipe; /**< Data IN Pipe configuration table. */ + USB_Pipe_Table_t DataOUTPipe; /**< Data OUT Pipe configuration table. */ + + uint8_t HIDInterfaceProtocol; /**< HID interface protocol value to match against if a specific + * boot subclass protocol is required, a protocol value from the + * \ref HID_Descriptor_ClassSubclassProtocol_t enum. + */ + #if !defined(HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY) + HID_ReportInfo_t* HIDParserData; /**< HID parser data to store the parsed HID report data, when boot protocol + * is not used. + * + * \note When the \c HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY compile time token is defined, + * this field is unavailable. + */ + #endif + } Config; /**< Config data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>must</b> be set or the interface will fail to enumerate and operate correctly. + */ + struct + { + bool IsActive; /**< Indicates if the current interface instance is connected to an attached device, valid + * after \ref HID_Host_ConfigurePipes() is called and the Host state machine is in the + * Configured state. + */ + uint8_t InterfaceNumber; /**< Interface index of the HID interface within the attached device. */ + + bool SupportsBootProtocol; /**< Indicates if the current interface instance supports the HID Boot + * Protocol when enabled via \ref HID_Host_SetBootProtocol(). + */ + bool DeviceUsesOUTPipe; /**< Indicates if the current interface instance uses a separate OUT data pipe for + * OUT reports, or if OUT reports are sent via the control pipe instead. + */ + bool UsingBootProtocol; /**< Indicates that the interface is currently initialized in Boot Protocol mode */ + uint16_t HIDReportSize; /**< Size in bytes of the HID report descriptor in the device. */ + + uint8_t LargestReportSize; /**< Largest report the device will send, in bytes. */ + } State; /**< State data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>may</b> be set to initial values, but may also be ignored to default to sane values when + * the interface is enumerated. + */ + } USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t; + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible error codes returned by the \ref HID_Host_ConfigurePipes() function. */ + enum HID_Host_EnumerationFailure_ErrorCodes_t + { + HID_ENUMERROR_NoError = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully. */ + HID_ENUMERROR_InvalidConfigDescriptor = 1, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor. */ + HID_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 2, /**< A compatible HID interface was not found in the device's Configuration Descriptor. */ + HID_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed = 3, /**< One or more pipes for the specified interface could not be configured correctly. */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Host interface configuration routine, to configure a given HID host interface instance using the Configuration + * Descriptor read from an attached USB device. This function automatically updates the given HID Host instance's + * state values and configures the pipes required to communicate with the interface if it is found within the + * device. This should be called once after the stack has enumerated the attached device, while the host state + * machine is in the Addressed state. + * + * \attention Once the device pipes are configured, the HID device's reporting protocol <b>must</b> be set via a call + * to either the \ref HID_Host_SetBootProtocol() or \ref HID_Host_SetReportProtocol() function. + * + * \param[in,out] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a HID Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] ConfigDescriptorSize Length of the attached device's Configuration Descriptor. + * \param[in] ConfigDescriptorData Pointer to a buffer containing the attached device's Configuration Descriptor. + * + * \return A value from the \ref HID_Host_EnumerationFailure_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t HID_Host_ConfigurePipes(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize, + void* ConfigDescriptorData) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + + /** Receives a HID IN report from the attached HID device, when a report has been received on the HID IN Data pipe. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \attention The destination buffer should be large enough to accommodate the largest report that the attached device + * can generate. + * + * \param[in,out] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a HID Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] Buffer Buffer to store the received report into. + * + * \return An error code from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t HID_Host_ReceiveReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + void* Buffer) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + #if !defined(HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY) + /** Receives a HID IN report from the attached device, by the report ID. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \note When the \c HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY compile time token is defined, this method is unavailable. + * + * \param[in,out] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a HID Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] ReportID Report ID of the received report if ControlRequest is false, set by the to the Report ID to fetch. + * \param[in] Buffer Buffer to store the received report into. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t HID_Host_ReceiveReportByID(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + void* Buffer) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + #endif + + /** Sends an OUT or FEATURE report to the currently attached HID device, using the device's OUT pipe if available, + * or the device's Control pipe if not. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \note When the \c HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY compile time token is defined, the ReportID parameter is removed + * from the parameter list of this function. + * + * \param[in,out] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a HID Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] ReportID Report ID of the report to send to the device, or 0 if the device does not use report IDs. + * \param[in] ReportType Type of report to issue to the device, either \ref HID_REPORT_ITEM_Out or \ref HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature. + * \param[in] Buffer Buffer containing the report to send to the attached device. + * \param[in] ReportSize Report size in bytes to send to the attached device. + * + * \return An error code from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum if the DeviceUsesOUTPipe flag is set in + * the interface's state structure, a value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum otherwise. + */ + uint8_t HID_Host_SendReportByID(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + #if !defined(HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY) + const uint8_t ReportID, + #endif + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t ReportSize) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) + #if !defined(HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(4); + #else + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + #endif + + /** Determines if a HID IN report has been received from the attached device on the data IN pipe. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a HID Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if a report has been received, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool HID_Host_IsReportReceived(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Switches the attached HID device's reporting protocol over to the Boot Report protocol mode, on supported devices. + * + * \note When the \c HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY compile time token is defined, this method must still be called + * to explicitly place the attached device into boot protocol mode before use. + * + * \param[in,out] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a HID Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return \ref HID_ERROR_LOGICAL if the device does not support Boot Protocol mode, a value from the + * \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum otherwise. + */ + uint8_t HID_Host_SetBootProtocol(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sets the idle period for the attached HID device to the specified interval. The HID idle period determines the rate + * at which the device should send a report, when no state changes have occurred; i.e. on HID keyboards, this sets the + * hardware key repeat interval. + * + * \param[in,out] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a HID Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] MS Idle period as a multiple of four milliseconds, zero to disable hardware repeats + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t HID_Host_SetIdlePeriod(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint16_t MS) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + #if !defined(HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY) + /** Switches the attached HID device's reporting protocol over to the standard Report protocol mode. This also retrieves + * and parses the device's HID report descriptor, so that the size of each report can be determined in advance. + * + * \attention Whether this function is used or not, the \ref CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem() callback from the HID + * Report Parser this function references <b>must</b> be implemented in the user code. + * + * \note When the \c HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY compile time token is defined, this method is unavailable. + * + * \param[in,out] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a HID Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum if an error occurs while retrieving the HID + * Report descriptor or the setting of the Report protocol, \ref HID_ERROR_LOGICAL if the HID interface does + * not have a valid \ref HID_ReportInfo_t structure set in its configuration, a mask of \ref HID_ERROR_LOGICAL + * and a value from the \ref HID_Parse_ErrorCodes_t otherwise. + */ + uint8_t HID_Host_SetReportProtocol(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + #endif + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** General management task for a given Human Interface Class host class interface, required for the correct operation of + * the interface. This should be called frequently in the main program loop, before the master USB management task + * \ref USB_USBTask(). + * + * \param[in,out] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a HID Class host configuration and state. + */ + static inline void HID_Host_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void HID_Host_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo) + { + (void)HIDInterfaceInfo; + } + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_HID_HOST_C) + static uint8_t DCOMP_HID_Host_NextHIDInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static uint8_t DCOMP_HID_Host_NextHIDDescriptor(void* const CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static uint8_t DCOMP_HID_Host_NextHIDInterfaceEndpoint(void* const CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + #endif + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MIDIClassHost.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MIDIClassHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..635148f5e2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MIDIClassHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,231 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../../Core/USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_MIDI_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_MIDI_HOST_C +#include "MIDIClassHost.h" + +uint8_t MIDI_Host_ConfigurePipes(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Host_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo, + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize, + void* ConfigDescriptorData) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* MIDIInterface = NULL; + + memset(&MIDIInterfaceInfo->State, 0x00, sizeof(MIDIInterfaceInfo->State)); + + if (DESCRIPTOR_TYPE(ConfigDescriptorData) != DTYPE_Configuration) + return MIDI_ENUMERROR_InvalidConfigDescriptor; + + while (!(DataINEndpoint) || !(DataOUTEndpoint)) + { + if (!(MIDIInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_MIDI_Host_NextMIDIStreamingDataEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_MIDI_Host_NextMIDIStreamingInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + return MIDI_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + MIDIInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + DataINEndpoint = NULL; + DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + + continue; + } + + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + else + DataOUTEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + + MIDIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize); + MIDIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.EndpointAddress = DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + MIDIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + + MIDIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointSize); + MIDIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.EndpointAddress = DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + MIDIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&MIDIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe, 1))) + return MIDI_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&MIDIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe, 1))) + return MIDI_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + MIDIInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceNumber = MIDIInterface->InterfaceNumber; + MIDIInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive = true; + + return MIDI_ENUMERROR_NoError; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_MIDI_Host_NextMIDIStreamingInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + if ((Interface->Class == AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == AUDIO_CSCP_MIDIStreamingSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == AUDIO_CSCP_StreamingProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_MIDI_Host_NextMIDIStreamingDataEndpoint(void* const CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* Endpoint = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + uint8_t EndpointType = (Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK); + + if ((EndpointType == EP_TYPE_BULK) && !(Pipe_IsEndpointBound(Endpoint->EndpointAddress))) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +void MIDI_Host_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Host_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(MIDIInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return; + + #if !defined(NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH) + MIDI_Host_Flush(MIDIInterfaceInfo); + #endif +} + +uint8_t MIDI_Host_Flush(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Host_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(MIDIInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(MIDIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (Pipe_BytesInPipe()) + { + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady()) != PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError) + { + Pipe_Freeze(); + return ErrorCode; + } + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError; +} + +uint8_t MIDI_Host_SendEventPacket(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Host_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo, + MIDI_EventPacket_t* const Event) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(MIDIInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(MIDIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(Event, sizeof(MIDI_EventPacket_t), NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + { + Pipe_Freeze(); + return ErrorCode; + } + + if (!(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +bool MIDI_Host_ReceiveEventPacket(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Host_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo, + MIDI_EventPacket_t* const Event) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(MIDIInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_DeviceDisconnected; + + bool DataReady = false; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(MIDIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + { + if (Pipe_BytesInPipe()) + { + Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(Event, sizeof(MIDI_EventPacket_t), NULL); + DataReady = true; + } + + if (!(Pipe_BytesInPipe())) + Pipe_ClearIN(); + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return DataReady; +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MIDIClassHost.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MIDIClassHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9cae21a1b6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MIDIClassHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,190 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Host mode driver for the library USB MIDI Class driver. + * + * Host mode driver for the library USB MIDI Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassMIDI + * \defgroup Group_USBClassMIDIHost MIDI Class Host Mode Driver + * + * \section Sec_USBClassMIDIHost_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MIDIClassHost.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassMIDIHost_ModDescription Module Description + * Host Mode USB Class driver framework interface, for the MIDI USB Class driver. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __MIDI_CLASS_HOST_H__ +#define __MIDI_CLASS_HOST_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../USB.h" + #include "../Common/MIDIClassCommon.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_MIDI_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief MIDI Class Host Mode Configuration and State Structure. + * + * Class state structure. An instance of this structure should be made within the user application, + * and passed to each of the MIDI class driver functions as the \c MIDIInterfaceInfo parameter. This + * stores each MIDI interface's configuration and state information. + */ + typedef struct + { + struct + { + USB_Pipe_Table_t DataINPipe; /**< Data IN Pipe configuration table. */ + USB_Pipe_Table_t DataOUTPipe; /**< Data OUT Pipe configuration table. */ + } Config; /**< Config data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>must</b> be set or the interface will fail to enumerate and operate correctly. + */ + struct + { + bool IsActive; /**< Indicates if the current interface instance is connected to an attached device, valid + * after \ref MIDI_Host_ConfigurePipes() is called and the Host state machine is in the + * Configured state. + */ + uint8_t InterfaceNumber; /**< Interface index of the MIDI interface within the attached device. */ + } State; /**< State data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>may</b> be set to initial values, but may also be ignored to default to sane values when + * the interface is enumerated. + */ + } USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Host_t; + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible error codes returned by the \ref MIDI_Host_ConfigurePipes() function. */ + enum MIDI_Host_EnumerationFailure_ErrorCodes_t + { + MIDI_ENUMERROR_NoError = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully. */ + MIDI_ENUMERROR_InvalidConfigDescriptor = 1, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor. */ + MIDI_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 2, /**< A compatible MIDI interface was not found in the device's Configuration Descriptor. */ + MIDI_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed = 3, /**< One or more pipes for the specified interface could not be configured correctly. */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Host interface configuration routine, to configure a given MIDI host interface instance using the Configuration + * Descriptor read from an attached USB device. This function automatically updates the given MIDI Host instance's + * state values and configures the pipes required to communicate with the interface if it is found within the device. + * This should be called once after the stack has enumerated the attached device, while the host state machine is in + * the Addressed state. + * + * \param[in,out] MIDIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an MIDI Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] ConfigDescriptorSize Length of the attached device's Configuration Descriptor. + * \param[in] ConfigDescriptorData Pointer to a buffer containing the attached device's Configuration Descriptor. + * + * \return A value from the \ref MIDI_Host_EnumerationFailure_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t MIDI_Host_ConfigurePipes(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Host_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo, + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize, + void* ConfigDescriptorData) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /** General management task for a given MIDI host class interface, required for the correct operation of the interface. This should + * be called frequently in the main program loop, before the master USB management task \ref USB_USBTask(). + * + * \param[in,out] MIDIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an MIDI Class host configuration and state. + */ + void MIDI_Host_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Host_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sends a MIDI event packet to the device. If no device is connected, the event packet is discarded. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] MIDIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a MIDI Class configuration and state. + * \param[in] Event Pointer to a populated USB_MIDI_EventPacket_t structure containing the MIDI event to send. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t MIDI_Host_SendEventPacket(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Host_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo, + MIDI_EventPacket_t* const Event) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Flushes the MIDI send buffer, sending any queued MIDI events to the device. This should be called to override the + * \ref MIDI_Host_SendEventPacket() function's packing behavior, to flush queued events. Events are queued into the + * pipe bank until either the pipe bank is full, or \ref MIDI_Host_Flush() is called. This allows for multiple MIDI + * events to be packed into a single pipe packet, increasing data throughput. + * + * \param[in,out] MIDIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a MIDI Class configuration and state. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t MIDI_Host_Flush(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Host_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Receives a MIDI event packet from the device. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] MIDIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a MIDI Class configuration and state. + * \param[out] Event Pointer to a USB_MIDI_EventPacket_t structure where the received MIDI event is to be placed. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if a MIDI event packet was received, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool MIDI_Host_ReceiveEventPacket(USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Host_t* const MIDIInterfaceInfo, + MIDI_EventPacket_t* const Event) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_MIDI_HOST_C) + static uint8_t DCOMP_MIDI_Host_NextMIDIStreamingInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static uint8_t DCOMP_MIDI_Host_NextMIDIStreamingDataEndpoint(void* const CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + #endif + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MassStorageClassHost.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MassStorageClassHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f7c5a6a738 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MassStorageClassHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,579 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../../Core/USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_MS_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_MASSSTORAGE_HOST_C +#include "MassStorageClassHost.h" + +uint8_t MS_Host_ConfigurePipes(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize, + void* ConfigDescriptorData) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* MassStorageInterface = NULL; + + memset(&MSInterfaceInfo->State, 0x00, sizeof(MSInterfaceInfo->State)); + + if (DESCRIPTOR_TYPE(ConfigDescriptorData) != DTYPE_Configuration) + return MS_ENUMERROR_InvalidConfigDescriptor; + + while (!(DataINEndpoint) || !(DataOUTEndpoint)) + { + if (!(MassStorageInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_MS_Host_NextMSInterfaceEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_MS_Host_NextMSInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + return MS_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + MassStorageInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + DataINEndpoint = NULL; + DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + + continue; + } + + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + else + DataOUTEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + + MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize); + MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.EndpointAddress = DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + + MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointSize); + MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.EndpointAddress = DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe, 1))) + return MS_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe, 1))) + return MS_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + MSInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceNumber = MassStorageInterface->InterfaceNumber; + MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive = true; + + return MS_ENUMERROR_NoError; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_MS_Host_NextMSInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + if ((Interface->Class == MS_CSCP_MassStorageClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == MS_CSCP_SCSITransparentSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == MS_CSCP_BulkOnlyTransportProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_MS_Host_NextMSInterfaceEndpoint(void* const CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* Endpoint = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + uint8_t EndpointType = (Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK); + + if ((EndpointType == EP_TYPE_BULK) && (!(Pipe_IsEndpointBound(Endpoint->EndpointAddress)))) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +static uint8_t MS_Host_SendCommand(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t* const SCSICommandBlock, + const void* const BufferPtr) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode = PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; + + if (++MSInterfaceInfo->State.TransactionTag == 0xFFFFFFFF) + MSInterfaceInfo->State.TransactionTag = 1; + + SCSICommandBlock->Signature = CPU_TO_LE32(MS_CBW_SIGNATURE); + SCSICommandBlock->Tag = cpu_to_le32(MSInterfaceInfo->State.TransactionTag); + + Pipe_SelectPipe(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(SCSICommandBlock, sizeof(MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t), + NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + Pipe_WaitUntilReady(); + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + if (BufferPtr != NULL) + { + ErrorCode = MS_Host_SendReceiveData(MSInterfaceInfo, SCSICommandBlock, (void*)BufferPtr); + + if ((ErrorCode != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) && (ErrorCode != PIPE_RWSTREAM_PipeStalled)) + { + Pipe_Freeze(); + return ErrorCode; + } + } + + MS_CommandStatusWrapper_t SCSIStatusBlock; + return MS_Host_GetReturnedStatus(MSInterfaceInfo, &SCSIStatusBlock); +} + +static uint8_t MS_Host_WaitForDataReceived(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint16_t TimeoutMSRem = MS_COMMAND_DATA_TIMEOUT_MS; + uint16_t PreviousFrameNumber = USB_Host_GetFrameNumber(); + + Pipe_SelectPipe(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + while (!(Pipe_IsINReceived())) + { + uint16_t CurrentFrameNumber = USB_Host_GetFrameNumber(); + + if (CurrentFrameNumber != PreviousFrameNumber) + { + PreviousFrameNumber = CurrentFrameNumber; + + if (!(TimeoutMSRem--)) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_Timeout; + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + Pipe_SelectPipe(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (Pipe_IsStalled()) + { + USB_Host_ClearEndpointStall(Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress()); + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_PipeStalled; + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + Pipe_SelectPipe(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (Pipe_IsStalled()) + { + USB_Host_ClearEndpointStall(Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress()); + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_PipeStalled; + } + + if (USB_HostState == HOST_STATE_Unattached) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + Pipe_SelectPipe(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +static uint8_t MS_Host_SendReceiveData(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t* const SCSICommandBlock, + void* BufferPtr) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode = PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; + uint16_t BytesRem = le32_to_cpu(SCSICommandBlock->DataTransferLength); + + if (SCSICommandBlock->Flags & MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_IN) + { + if ((ErrorCode = MS_Host_WaitForDataReceived(MSInterfaceInfo)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + { + Pipe_Freeze(); + return ErrorCode; + } + + Pipe_SelectPipe(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(BufferPtr, BytesRem, NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + Pipe_ClearIN(); + } + else + { + Pipe_SelectPipe(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(BufferPtr, BytesRem, NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + while (!(Pipe_IsOUTReady())) + { + if (USB_HostState == HOST_STATE_Unattached) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + } + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return ErrorCode; +} + +static uint8_t MS_Host_GetReturnedStatus(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + MS_CommandStatusWrapper_t* const SCSICommandStatus) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode = PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; + + if ((ErrorCode = MS_Host_WaitForDataReceived(MSInterfaceInfo)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(SCSICommandStatus, sizeof(MS_CommandStatusWrapper_t), + NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + Pipe_ClearIN(); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + if (SCSICommandStatus->Status != MS_SCSI_COMMAND_Pass) + ErrorCode = MS_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED; + + return ErrorCode; +} + +uint8_t MS_Host_ResetMSInterface(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = MS_REQ_MassStorageReset, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = MSInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceNumber, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(NULL)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_ClearEndpointStall(Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress())) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(MSInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_ClearEndpointStall(Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress())) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ErrorCode; + + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; +} + +uint8_t MS_Host_GetMaxLUN(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const MaxLUNIndex) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = MS_REQ_GetMaxLUN, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = MSInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceNumber, + .wLength = 1, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(MaxLUNIndex)) == HOST_SENDCONTROL_SetupStalled) + { + *MaxLUNIndex = 0; + ErrorCode = HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; + } + + return ErrorCode; +} + +uint8_t MS_Host_GetInquiryData(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t LUNIndex, + SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t* const InquiryData) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_DeviceDisconnected; + + MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t SCSICommandBlock = (MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t) + { + .DataTransferLength = CPU_TO_LE32(sizeof(SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t)), + .Flags = MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_IN, + .LUN = LUNIndex, + .SCSICommandLength = 6, + .SCSICommandData = + { + SCSI_CMD_INQUIRY, + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Reserved + sizeof(SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t), // Allocation Length + 0x00 // Unused (control) + } + }; + + return MS_Host_SendCommand(MSInterfaceInfo, &SCSICommandBlock, InquiryData); +} + +uint8_t MS_Host_TestUnitReady(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t LUNIndex) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_DeviceDisconnected; + + MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t SCSICommandBlock = (MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t) + { + .DataTransferLength = CPU_TO_LE32(0), + .Flags = MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_IN, + .LUN = LUNIndex, + .SCSICommandLength = 6, + .SCSICommandData = + { + SCSI_CMD_TEST_UNIT_READY, + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00 // Unused (control) + } + }; + + return MS_Host_SendCommand(MSInterfaceInfo, &SCSICommandBlock, NULL); +} + +uint8_t MS_Host_ReadDeviceCapacity(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t LUNIndex, + SCSI_Capacity_t* const DeviceCapacity) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t SCSICommandBlock = (MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t) + { + .DataTransferLength = CPU_TO_LE32(sizeof(SCSI_Capacity_t)), + .Flags = MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_IN, + .LUN = LUNIndex, + .SCSICommandLength = 10, + .SCSICommandData = + { + SCSI_CMD_READ_CAPACITY_10, + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // MSB of Logical block address + 0x00, + 0x00, + 0x00, // LSB of Logical block address + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Partial Medium Indicator + 0x00 // Unused (control) + } + }; + + if ((ErrorCode = MS_Host_SendCommand(MSInterfaceInfo, &SCSICommandBlock, DeviceCapacity)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + DeviceCapacity->Blocks = BE32_TO_CPU(DeviceCapacity->Blocks); + DeviceCapacity->BlockSize = BE32_TO_CPU(DeviceCapacity->BlockSize); + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +uint8_t MS_Host_RequestSense(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t LUNIndex, + SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t* const SenseData) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_DeviceDisconnected; + + MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t SCSICommandBlock = (MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t) + { + .DataTransferLength = CPU_TO_LE32(sizeof(SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t)), + .Flags = MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_IN, + .LUN = LUNIndex, + .SCSICommandLength = 6, + .SCSICommandData = + { + SCSI_CMD_REQUEST_SENSE, + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Reserved + sizeof(SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t), // Allocation Length + 0x00 // Unused (control) + } + }; + + return MS_Host_SendCommand(MSInterfaceInfo, &SCSICommandBlock, SenseData); +} + +uint8_t MS_Host_PreventAllowMediumRemoval(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t LUNIndex, + const bool PreventRemoval) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_DeviceDisconnected; + + MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t SCSICommandBlock = (MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t) + { + .DataTransferLength = CPU_TO_LE32(0), + .Flags = MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_OUT, + .LUN = LUNIndex, + .SCSICommandLength = 6, + .SCSICommandData = + { + SCSI_CMD_PREVENT_ALLOW_MEDIUM_REMOVAL, + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // Reserved + PreventRemoval, // Prevent flag + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00 // Unused (control) + } + }; + + return MS_Host_SendCommand(MSInterfaceInfo, &SCSICommandBlock, NULL); +} + +uint8_t MS_Host_ReadDeviceBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t LUNIndex, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + const uint8_t Blocks, + const uint16_t BlockSize, + void* BlockBuffer) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_DeviceDisconnected; + + MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t SCSICommandBlock = (MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t) + { + .DataTransferLength = cpu_to_le32((uint32_t)Blocks * BlockSize), + .Flags = MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_IN, + .LUN = LUNIndex, + .SCSICommandLength = 10, + .SCSICommandData = + { + SCSI_CMD_READ_10, + 0x00, // Unused (control bits, all off) + (BlockAddress >> 24), // MSB of Block Address + (BlockAddress >> 16), + (BlockAddress >> 8), + (BlockAddress & 0xFF), // LSB of Block Address + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // MSB of Total Blocks to Read + Blocks, // LSB of Total Blocks to Read + 0x00 // Unused (control) + } + }; + + return MS_Host_SendCommand(MSInterfaceInfo, &SCSICommandBlock, BlockBuffer); +} + +uint8_t MS_Host_WriteDeviceBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t LUNIndex, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + const uint8_t Blocks, + const uint16_t BlockSize, + const void* BlockBuffer) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_DeviceDisconnected; + + MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t SCSICommandBlock = (MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t) + { + .DataTransferLength = cpu_to_le32((uint32_t)Blocks * BlockSize), + .Flags = MS_COMMAND_DIR_DATA_OUT, + .LUN = LUNIndex, + .SCSICommandLength = 10, + .SCSICommandData = + { + SCSI_CMD_WRITE_10, + 0x00, // Unused (control bits, all off) + (BlockAddress >> 24), // MSB of Block Address + (BlockAddress >> 16), + (BlockAddress >> 8), + (BlockAddress & 0xFF), // LSB of Block Address + 0x00, // Reserved + 0x00, // MSB of Total Blocks to Write + Blocks, // LSB of Total Blocks to Write + 0x00 // Unused (control) + } + }; + + return MS_Host_SendCommand(MSInterfaceInfo, &SCSICommandBlock, BlockBuffer); +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MassStorageClassHost.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MassStorageClassHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..348050f8f5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MassStorageClassHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,335 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Host mode driver for the library USB Mass Storage Class driver. + * + * Host mode driver for the library USB Mass Storage Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassMS + * \defgroup Group_USBClassMassStorageHost Mass Storage Class Host Mode Driver + * + * \section Sec_USBClassMassStorageHost_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MassStorageClassHost.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassMassStorageHost_ModDescription Module Description + * Host Mode USB Class driver framework interface, for the Mass Storage USB Class driver. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __MS_CLASS_HOST_H__ +#define __MS_CLASS_HOST_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../USB.h" + #include "../Common/MassStorageClassCommon.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_MS_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Error code for some Mass Storage Host functions, indicating a logical (and not hardware) error. */ + #define MS_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED 0x80 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief Mass Storage Class Host Mode Configuration and State Structure. + * + * Class state structure. An instance of this structure should be made within the user application, + * and passed to each of the Mass Storage class driver functions as the \c MSInterfaceInfo parameter. This + * stores each Mass Storage interface's configuration and state information. + */ + typedef struct + { + struct + { + USB_Pipe_Table_t DataINPipe; /**< Data IN Pipe configuration table. */ + USB_Pipe_Table_t DataOUTPipe; /**< Data OUT Pipe configuration table. */ + } Config; /**< Config data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>must</b> be set or the interface will fail to enumerate and operate correctly. + */ + struct + { + bool IsActive; /**< Indicates if the current interface instance is connected to an attached device, valid + * after \ref MS_Host_ConfigurePipes() is called and the Host state machine is in the + * Configured state. + */ + uint8_t InterfaceNumber; /**< Interface index of the Mass Storage interface within the attached device. */ + + uint32_t TransactionTag; /**< Current transaction tag for data synchronizing of packets. */ + } State; /**< State data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>may</b> be set to initial values, but may also be ignored to default to sane values when + * the interface is enumerated. + */ + } USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t; + + /** \brief SCSI Device LUN Capacity Structure. + * + * SCSI capacity structure, to hold the total capacity of the device in both the number + * of blocks in the current LUN, and the size of each block. This structure is filled by + * the device when the \ref MS_Host_ReadDeviceCapacity() function is called. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint32_t Blocks; /**< Number of blocks in the addressed LUN of the device. */ + uint32_t BlockSize; /**< Number of bytes in each block in the addressed LUN. */ + } SCSI_Capacity_t; + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible error codes returned by the \ref MS_Host_ConfigurePipes() function. */ + enum MS_Host_EnumerationFailure_ErrorCodes_t + { + MS_ENUMERROR_NoError = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully. */ + MS_ENUMERROR_InvalidConfigDescriptor = 1, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor. */ + MS_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 2, /**< A compatible Mass Storage interface was not found in the device's Configuration Descriptor. */ + MS_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed = 3, /**< One or more pipes for the specified interface could not be configured correctly. */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Host interface configuration routine, to configure a given Mass Storage host interface instance using the + * Configuration Descriptor read from an attached USB device. This function automatically updates the given Mass + * Storage Host instance's state values and configures the pipes required to communicate with the interface if it + * is found within the device. This should be called once after the stack has enumerated the attached device, while + * the host state machine is in the Addressed state. + * + * \param[in,out] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an MS Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] ConfigDescriptorSize Length of the attached device's Configuration Descriptor. + * \param[in] DeviceConfigDescriptor Pointer to a buffer containing the attached device's Configuration Descriptor. + * + * \return A value from the \ref MS_Host_EnumerationFailure_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t MS_Host_ConfigurePipes(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize, + void* DeviceConfigDescriptor) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /** Sends a MASS STORAGE RESET control request to the attached device, resetting the Mass Storage Interface + * and readying it for the next Mass Storage command. This should be called after a failed SCSI request to + * ensure the attached Mass Storage device is ready to receive the next command. + * + * \param[in,out] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a MS Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t MS_Host_ResetMSInterface(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sends a GET MAX LUN control request to the attached device, retrieving the index of the highest LUN (Logical + * UNit, a logical drive) in the device. This value can then be used in the other functions of the Mass Storage + * Host mode Class driver to address a specific LUN within the device. + * + * \note Some devices do not support this request, and will STALL it when issued. To get around this, + * on unsupported devices the max LUN index will be reported as zero and no error will be returned + * if the device STALLs the request. + * + * \param[in,out] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a MS Class host configuration and state. + * \param[out] MaxLUNIndex Pointer to a location where the highest LUN index value should be stored. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t MS_Host_GetMaxLUN(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const MaxLUNIndex) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Retrieves the Mass Storage device's inquiry data for the specified LUN, indicating the device characteristics and + * properties. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a MS Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] LUNIndex LUN index within the device the command is being issued to. + * \param[out] InquiryData Location where the read inquiry data should be stored. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum or \ref MS_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED. + */ + uint8_t MS_Host_GetInquiryData(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t LUNIndex, + SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t* const InquiryData) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /** Sends a TEST UNIT READY command to the device, to determine if it is ready to accept other SCSI commands. + * + * \param[in,out] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a MS Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] LUNIndex LUN index within the device the command is being issued to. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum or \ref MS_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED if not ready. + */ + uint8_t MS_Host_TestUnitReady(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t LUNIndex) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Retrieves the total capacity of the attached USB Mass Storage device, in blocks, and block size. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a MS Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] LUNIndex LUN index within the device the command is being issued to. + * \param[out] DeviceCapacity Pointer to the location where the capacity information should be stored. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum or \ref MS_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED if not ready. + */ + uint8_t MS_Host_ReadDeviceCapacity(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t LUNIndex, + SCSI_Capacity_t* const DeviceCapacity) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /** Retrieves the device sense data, indicating the current device state and error codes for the previously + * issued command. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a MS Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] LUNIndex LUN index within the device the command is being issued to. + * \param[out] SenseData Pointer to the location where the sense information should be stored. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum or \ref MS_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED if not ready. + */ + uint8_t MS_Host_RequestSense(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t LUNIndex, + SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t* const SenseData) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /** Issues a PREVENT MEDIUM REMOVAL command, to logically (or, depending on the type of device, physically) lock + * the device from removal so that blocks of data on the medium can be read or altered. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a MS Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] LUNIndex LUN index within the device the command is being issued to. + * \param[in] PreventRemoval Boolean \c true if the device should be locked from removal, \c false otherwise. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum or \ref MS_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED if not ready. + */ + uint8_t MS_Host_PreventAllowMediumRemoval(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t LUNIndex, + const bool PreventRemoval) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads blocks of data from the attached Mass Storage device's medium. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a MS Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] LUNIndex LUN index within the device the command is being issued to. + * \param[in] BlockAddress Starting block address within the device to read from. + * \param[in] Blocks Total number of blocks to read. + * \param[in] BlockSize Size in bytes of each block within the device. + * \param[out] BlockBuffer Pointer to where the read data from the device should be stored. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum or \ref MS_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED if not ready. + */ + uint8_t MS_Host_ReadDeviceBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t LUNIndex, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + const uint8_t Blocks, + const uint16_t BlockSize, + void* BlockBuffer) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(6); + + /** Writes blocks of data to the attached Mass Storage device's medium. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a MS Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] LUNIndex LUN index within the device the command is being issued to. + * \param[in] BlockAddress Starting block address within the device to write to. + * \param[in] Blocks Total number of blocks to read. + * \param[in] BlockSize Size in bytes of each block within the device. + * \param[in] BlockBuffer Pointer to where the data to write should be sourced from. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum or \ref MS_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED if not ready. + */ + uint8_t MS_Host_WriteDeviceBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t LUNIndex, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + const uint8_t Blocks, + const uint16_t BlockSize, + const void* BlockBuffer) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(6); + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** General management task for a given Mass Storage host class interface, required for the correct operation of + * the interface. This should be called frequently in the main program loop, before the master USB management task + * \ref USB_USBTask(). + * + * \param[in,out] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an Mass Storage Class host configuration and state. + */ + static inline void MS_Host_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void MS_Host_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) + { + (void)MSInterfaceInfo; + } + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define MS_COMMAND_DATA_TIMEOUT_MS 10000 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_MASSSTORAGE_HOST_C) + static uint8_t MS_Host_SendCommand(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t* const SCSICommandBlock, + const void* const BufferPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + static uint8_t MS_Host_WaitForDataReceived(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static uint8_t MS_Host_SendReceiveData(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + MS_CommandBlockWrapper_t* const SCSICommandBlock, + void* BufferPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + static uint8_t MS_Host_GetReturnedStatus(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Host_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + MS_CommandStatusWrapper_t* const SCSICommandStatus) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + static uint8_t DCOMP_MS_Host_NextMSInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static uint8_t DCOMP_MS_Host_NextMSInterfaceEndpoint(void* const CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + #endif + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/PrinterClassHost.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/PrinterClassHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8a04d0ab8b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/PrinterClassHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,400 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../../Core/USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_PRINTER_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_PRINTER_HOST_C +#include "PrinterClassHost.h" + +uint8_t PRNT_Host_ConfigurePipes(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize, + void* ConfigDescriptorData) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* PrinterInterface = NULL; + + memset(&PRNTInterfaceInfo->State, 0x00, sizeof(PRNTInterfaceInfo->State)); + + if (DESCRIPTOR_TYPE(ConfigDescriptorData) != DTYPE_Configuration) + return PRNT_ENUMERROR_InvalidConfigDescriptor; + + while (!(DataINEndpoint) || !(DataOUTEndpoint)) + { + if (!(PrinterInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_PRNT_Host_NextPRNTInterfaceEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_PRNT_Host_NextPRNTInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + return PRNT_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + PrinterInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + DataINEndpoint = NULL; + DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + + continue; + } + + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + else + DataOUTEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + + PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize); + PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.EndpointAddress = DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + + PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointSize); + PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.EndpointAddress = DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe, 1))) + return PRNT_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe, 1))) + return PRNT_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceNumber = PrinterInterface->InterfaceNumber; + PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.AlternateSetting = PrinterInterface->AlternateSetting; + PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive = true; + + return PRNT_ENUMERROR_NoError; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_PRNT_Host_NextPRNTInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + if ((Interface->Class == PRNT_CSCP_PrinterClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == PRNT_CSCP_PrinterSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == PRNT_CSCP_BidirectionalProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_PRNT_Host_NextPRNTInterfaceEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* Endpoint = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + uint8_t EndpointType = (Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK); + + if (EndpointType == EP_TYPE_BULK) + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +void PRNT_Host_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return; + + #if !defined(NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH) + PRNT_Host_Flush(PRNTInterfaceInfo); + #endif +} + +uint8_t PRNT_Host_SetBidirectionalMode(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) +{ + if (PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.AlternateSetting) + { + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SetInterfaceAltSetting(PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceNumber, + PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.AlternateSetting)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + } + + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; +} + +uint8_t PRNT_Host_GetPortStatus(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const PortStatus) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = PRNT_REQ_GetPortStatus, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceNumber, + .wLength = sizeof(uint8_t), + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(PortStatus); +} + +uint8_t PRNT_Host_SoftReset(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = PRNT_REQ_SoftReset, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceNumber, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(NULL); +} + +uint8_t PRNT_Host_Flush(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (!(Pipe_BytesInPipe())) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError; + + bool BankFull = !(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed()); + + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + if (BankFull) + { + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady()) != PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError; +} + +uint8_t PRNT_Host_SendByte(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t Data) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (!(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady()) != PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + } + + Pipe_Write_8(Data); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError; +} + +uint8_t PRNT_Host_SendString(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + const char* const String) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(String, strlen(String), NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady(); + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return ErrorCode; +} + +uint8_t PRNT_Host_SendData(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + const void* Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(Buffer, Length, NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady(); + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return ErrorCode; +} + +uint16_t PRNT_Host_BytesReceived(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return 0; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + { + if (!(Pipe_BytesInPipe())) + { + Pipe_ClearIN(); + Pipe_Freeze(); + return 0; + } + else + { + Pipe_Freeze(); + return Pipe_BytesInPipe(); + } + } + else + { + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return 0; + } +} + +int16_t PRNT_Host_ReceiveByte(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + int16_t ReceivedByte = -1; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PRNTInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + { + if (Pipe_BytesInPipe()) + ReceivedByte = Pipe_Read_8(); + + if (!(Pipe_BytesInPipe())) + Pipe_ClearIN(); + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return ReceivedByte; +} + +uint8_t PRNT_Host_GetDeviceID(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + char* const DeviceIDString, + const uint16_t BufferSize) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + uint16_t DeviceIDStringLength = 0; + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = PRNT_REQ_GetDeviceID, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = PRNTInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceNumber, + .wLength = sizeof(DeviceIDStringLength), + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(&DeviceIDStringLength)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ErrorCode; + + if (!(DeviceIDStringLength)) + { + DeviceIDString[0] = 0x00; + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; + } + + DeviceIDStringLength = be16_to_cpu(DeviceIDStringLength); + + if (DeviceIDStringLength > BufferSize) + DeviceIDStringLength = BufferSize; + + USB_ControlRequest.wLength = DeviceIDStringLength; + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(DeviceIDString)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ErrorCode; + + memmove(&DeviceIDString[0], &DeviceIDString[2], DeviceIDStringLength - 2); + + DeviceIDString[DeviceIDStringLength - 2] = 0x00; + + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/PrinterClassHost.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/PrinterClassHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..511dab4b40 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/PrinterClassHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,285 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Host mode driver for the library USB Printer Class driver. + * + * Host mode driver for the library USB Printer Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassPrinter + * \defgroup Group_USBClassPrinterHost Printer Class Host Mode Driver + * + * \section Sec_USBClassPrinterHost_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/PrinterClassHost.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassPrinterHost_ModDescription Module Description + * Host Mode USB Class driver framework interface, for the Printer USB Class driver. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __PRINTER_CLASS_HOST_H__ +#define __PRINTER_CLASS_HOST_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../USB.h" + #include "../Common/PrinterClassCommon.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_PRINTER_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief Printer Class Host Mode Configuration and State Structure. + * + * Class state structure. An instance of this structure should be made within the user application, + * and passed to each of the Printer class driver functions as the \c PRNTInterfaceInfo parameter. This + * stores each Printer interface's configuration and state information. + */ + typedef struct + { + struct + { + USB_Pipe_Table_t DataINPipe; /**< Data IN Pipe configuration table. */ + USB_Pipe_Table_t DataOUTPipe; /**< Data OUT Pipe configuration table. */ + } Config; /**< Config data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>must</b> be set or the interface will fail to enumerate and operate correctly. + */ + struct + { + bool IsActive; /**< Indicates if the current interface instance is connected to an attached device, valid + * after \ref PRNT_Host_ConfigurePipes() is called and the Host state machine is in the + * Configured state. + */ + uint8_t InterfaceNumber; /**< Interface index of the Printer interface within the attached device. */ + uint8_t AlternateSetting; /**< Alternate setting within the Printer Interface in the attached device. */ + } State; /**< State data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>may</b> be set to initial values, but may also be ignored to default to sane values when + * the interface is enumerated. + */ + } USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t; + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible error codes returned by the \ref PRNT_Host_ConfigurePipes() function. */ + enum PRNT_Host_EnumerationFailure_ErrorCodes_t + { + PRNT_ENUMERROR_NoError = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully. */ + PRNT_ENUMERROR_InvalidConfigDescriptor = 1, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor. */ + PRNT_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 2, /**< A compatible Printer interface was not found in the device's Configuration Descriptor. */ + PRNT_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed = 3, /**< One or more pipes for the specified interface could not be configured correctly. */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Host interface configuration routine, to configure a given Printer host interface instance using the + * Configuration Descriptor read from an attached USB device. This function automatically updates the given Printer + * instance's state values and configures the pipes required to communicate with the interface if it is found within + * the device. This should be called once after the stack has enumerated the attached device, while the host state + * machine is in the Addressed state. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] ConfigDescriptorSize Length of the attached device's Configuration Descriptor. + * \param[in] ConfigDescriptorData Pointer to a buffer containing the attached device's Configuration Descriptor. + * + * \return A value from the \ref PRNT_Host_EnumerationFailure_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t PRNT_Host_ConfigurePipes(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize, + void* ConfigDescriptorData) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /** General management task for a given Printer host class interface, required for the correct operation of + * the interface. This should be called frequently in the main program loop, before the master USB management task + * \ref USB_USBTask(). + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class host configuration and state. + */ + void PRNT_Host_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Configures the printer to enable Bidirectional mode, if it is not already in this mode. This should be called + * once the connected device's configuration has been set, to ensure the printer is ready to accept commands. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t PRNT_Host_SetBidirectionalMode(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Retrieves the status of the virtual Printer port's inbound status lines. The result can then be masked against the + * \c PRNT_PORTSTATUS_* macros to determine the printer port's status. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class host configuration and state. + * \param[out] PortStatus Location where the retrieved port status should be stored. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t PRNT_Host_GetPortStatus(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const PortStatus) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Soft-resets the attached printer, readying it for new commands. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t PRNT_Host_SoftReset(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Flushes any data waiting to be sent, ensuring that the send buffer is cleared. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t PRNT_Host_Flush(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sends the given null terminated string to the attached printer's input endpoint. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] String Pointer to a null terminated string to send. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t PRNT_Host_SendString(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + const char* const String) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Sends the given raw data stream to the attached printer's input endpoint. This should contain commands that the + * printer is able to understand - for example, PCL data. Not all printers accept all printer languages; see + * \ref PRNT_Host_GetDeviceID() for details on determining acceptable languages for an attached printer. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to a buffer containing the raw command stream to send to the printer. + * \param[in] Length Size in bytes of the command stream to be sent. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t PRNT_Host_SendData(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + const void* Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Sends a given byte to the attached USB device, if connected. If a device is not connected when the function is called, the + * byte is discarded. Bytes will be queued for transmission to the device until either the pipe bank becomes full, or the + * \ref PRNT_Host_Flush() function is called to flush the pending data to the host. This allows for multiple bytes to be + * packed into a single pipe packet, increasing data throughput. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] Data Byte of data to send to the device. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t PRNT_Host_SendByte(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t Data) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Determines the number of bytes received by the printer interface from the device, waiting to be read. This indicates the number + * of bytes in the IN pipe bank only, and thus the number of calls to \ref PRNT_Host_ReceiveByte() which are guaranteed to succeed + * immediately. If multiple bytes are to be received, they should be buffered by the user application, as the pipe bank will not be + * released back to the USB controller until all bytes are read. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return Total number of buffered bytes received from the device. + */ + uint16_t PRNT_Host_BytesReceived(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads a byte of data from the device. If no data is waiting to be read of if a USB device is not connected, the function + * returns a negative value. The \ref PRNT_Host_BytesReceived() function may be queried in advance to determine how many bytes + * are currently buffered in the Printer interface's data receive pipe. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return Next received byte from the device, or a negative value if no data received. + */ + int16_t PRNT_Host_ReceiveByte(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Retrieves the attached printer device's ID string, formatted according to IEEE 1284. This string is sent as a + * Unicode string from the device and is automatically converted to an ASCII encoded C string by this function, thus + * the maximum reportable string length is two less than the size given (to accommodate the Unicode string length + * bytes which are removed). + * + * This string, when supported, contains the model, manufacturer and acceptable printer languages for the attached device. + * + * \param[in,out] PRNTInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Printer Class host configuration and state. + * \param[out] DeviceIDString Pointer to a buffer where the Device ID string should be stored, in ASCII format. + * \param[in] BufferSize Size in bytes of the buffer allocated for the Device ID string. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t PRNT_Host_GetDeviceID(USB_ClassInfo_PRNT_Host_t* const PRNTInterfaceInfo, + char* const DeviceIDString, + const uint16_t BufferSize) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_PRINTER_HOST_C) + static uint8_t DCOMP_PRNT_Host_NextPRNTInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static uint8_t DCOMP_PRNT_Host_NextPRNTInterfaceEndpoint(void* const CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + #endif + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/RNDISClassHost.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/RNDISClassHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6fb09fdab2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/RNDISClassHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,476 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../../Core/USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_RNDIS_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_RNDIS_HOST_C +#include "RNDISClassHost.h" + +uint8_t RNDIS_Host_ConfigurePipes(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize, + void* ConfigDescriptorData) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* NotificationEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* RNDISControlInterface = NULL; + + memset(&RNDISInterfaceInfo->State, 0x00, sizeof(RNDISInterfaceInfo->State)); + + if (DESCRIPTOR_TYPE(ConfigDescriptorData) != DTYPE_Configuration) + return RNDIS_ENUMERROR_InvalidConfigDescriptor; + + RNDISControlInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + while (!(DataINEndpoint) || !(DataOUTEndpoint) || !(NotificationEndpoint)) + { + if (!(RNDISControlInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_RNDIS_Host_NextRNDISInterfaceEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + if (NotificationEndpoint) + { + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_RNDIS_Host_NextRNDISDataInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + return RNDIS_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + DataINEndpoint = NULL; + DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + } + else + { + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_RNDIS_Host_NextRNDISControlInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + return RNDIS_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + RNDISControlInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + NotificationEndpoint = NULL; + } + + continue; + } + + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + { + if ((EndpointData->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK) == EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT) + NotificationEndpoint = EndpointData; + else + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + else + { + DataOUTEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + } + + RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize); + RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.EndpointAddress = DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + + RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointSize); + RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.EndpointAddress = DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + + RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.NotificationPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(NotificationEndpoint->EndpointSize); + RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.NotificationPipe.EndpointAddress = NotificationEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.NotificationPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe, 1))) + return RNDIS_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe, 1))) + return RNDIS_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.NotificationPipe, 1))) + return RNDIS_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.ControlInterfaceNumber = RNDISControlInterface->InterfaceNumber; + RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive = true; + + return RNDIS_ENUMERROR_NoError; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_RNDIS_Host_NextRNDISControlInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + if ((Interface->Class == CDC_CSCP_CDCClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == CDC_CSCP_VendorSpecificProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_RNDIS_Host_NextRNDISDataInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + if ((Interface->Class == CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +static uint8_t DCOMP_RNDIS_Host_NextRNDISInterfaceEndpoint(void* const CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* Endpoint = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + uint8_t EndpointType = (Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK); + + if (((EndpointType == EP_TYPE_BULK) || (EndpointType == EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT)) && + !(Pipe_IsEndpointBound(Endpoint->EndpointAddress))) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +static uint8_t RNDIS_SendEncapsulatedCommand(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = RNDIS_REQ_SendEncapsulatedCommand, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.ControlInterfaceNumber, + .wLength = Length, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(Buffer); +} + +static uint8_t RNDIS_GetEncapsulatedResponse(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = RNDIS_REQ_GetEncapsulatedResponse, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.ControlInterfaceNumber, + .wLength = Length, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(Buffer); +} + +uint8_t RNDIS_Host_SendKeepAlive(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + RNDIS_KeepAlive_Message_t KeepAliveMessage; + RNDIS_KeepAlive_Complete_t KeepAliveMessageResponse; + + KeepAliveMessage.MessageType = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_KEEPALIVE_MSG); + KeepAliveMessage.MessageLength = CPU_TO_LE32(sizeof(RNDIS_KeepAlive_Message_t)); + KeepAliveMessage.RequestId = cpu_to_le32(RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.RequestID++); + + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_SendEncapsulatedCommand(RNDISInterfaceInfo, &KeepAliveMessage, + sizeof(RNDIS_KeepAlive_Message_t))) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_GetEncapsulatedResponse(RNDISInterfaceInfo, &KeepAliveMessageResponse, + sizeof(RNDIS_KeepAlive_Complete_t))) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; +} + +uint8_t RNDIS_Host_InitializeDevice(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + RNDIS_Initialize_Message_t InitMessage; + RNDIS_Initialize_Complete_t InitMessageResponse; + + InitMessage.MessageType = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_INITIALIZE_MSG); + InitMessage.MessageLength = CPU_TO_LE32(sizeof(RNDIS_Initialize_Message_t)); + InitMessage.RequestId = cpu_to_le32(RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.RequestID++); + + InitMessage.MajorVersion = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_VERSION_MAJOR); + InitMessage.MinorVersion = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_VERSION_MINOR); + InitMessage.MaxTransferSize = cpu_to_le32(RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.HostMaxPacketSize); + + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_SendEncapsulatedCommand(RNDISInterfaceInfo, &InitMessage, + sizeof(RNDIS_Initialize_Message_t))) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_GetEncapsulatedResponse(RNDISInterfaceInfo, &InitMessageResponse, + sizeof(RNDIS_Initialize_Complete_t))) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + if (InitMessageResponse.Status != CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_SUCCESS)) + return RNDIS_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED; + + RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.DeviceMaxPacketSize = le32_to_cpu(InitMessageResponse.MaxTransferSize); + + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; +} + +uint8_t RNDIS_Host_SetRNDISProperty(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t Oid, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + struct + { + RNDIS_Set_Message_t SetMessage; + uint8_t ContiguousBuffer[Length]; + } SetMessageData; + + RNDIS_Set_Complete_t SetMessageResponse; + + SetMessageData.SetMessage.MessageType = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_SET_MSG); + SetMessageData.SetMessage.MessageLength = cpu_to_le32(sizeof(RNDIS_Set_Message_t) + Length); + SetMessageData.SetMessage.RequestId = cpu_to_le32(RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.RequestID++); + + SetMessageData.SetMessage.Oid = cpu_to_le32(Oid); + SetMessageData.SetMessage.InformationBufferLength = cpu_to_le32(Length); + SetMessageData.SetMessage.InformationBufferOffset = CPU_TO_LE32(sizeof(RNDIS_Set_Message_t) - sizeof(RNDIS_Message_Header_t)); + SetMessageData.SetMessage.DeviceVcHandle = CPU_TO_LE32(0); + + memcpy(&SetMessageData.ContiguousBuffer, Buffer, Length); + + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_SendEncapsulatedCommand(RNDISInterfaceInfo, &SetMessageData, + (sizeof(RNDIS_Set_Message_t) + Length))) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_GetEncapsulatedResponse(RNDISInterfaceInfo, &SetMessageResponse, + sizeof(RNDIS_Set_Complete_t))) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + if (SetMessageResponse.Status != CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_SUCCESS)) + return RNDIS_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED; + + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; +} + +uint8_t RNDIS_Host_QueryRNDISProperty(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t Oid, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t MaxLength) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + RNDIS_Query_Message_t QueryMessage; + + struct + { + RNDIS_Query_Complete_t QueryMessageResponse; + uint8_t ContiguousBuffer[MaxLength]; + } QueryMessageResponseData; + + QueryMessage.MessageType = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_QUERY_MSG); + QueryMessage.MessageLength = CPU_TO_LE32(sizeof(RNDIS_Query_Message_t)); + QueryMessage.RequestId = cpu_to_le32(RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.RequestID++); + + QueryMessage.Oid = cpu_to_le32(Oid); + QueryMessage.InformationBufferLength = CPU_TO_LE32(0); + QueryMessage.InformationBufferOffset = CPU_TO_LE32(0); + QueryMessage.DeviceVcHandle = CPU_TO_LE32(0); + + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_SendEncapsulatedCommand(RNDISInterfaceInfo, &QueryMessage, + sizeof(RNDIS_Query_Message_t))) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = RNDIS_GetEncapsulatedResponse(RNDISInterfaceInfo, &QueryMessageResponseData, + sizeof(QueryMessageResponseData))) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + if (QueryMessageResponseData.QueryMessageResponse.Status != CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_STATUS_SUCCESS)) + return RNDIS_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED; + + memcpy(Buffer, &QueryMessageResponseData.ContiguousBuffer, MaxLength); + + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; +} + +bool RNDIS_Host_IsPacketReceived(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo) +{ + bool PacketWaiting; + + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return false; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + PacketWaiting = Pipe_IsINReceived(); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PacketWaiting; +} + +uint8_t RNDIS_Host_ReadPacket(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + void* Buffer, + uint16_t* const PacketLength) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (!(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + Pipe_ClearIN(); + + *PacketLength = 0; + Pipe_Freeze(); + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; + } + + RNDIS_Packet_Message_t DeviceMessage; + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(&DeviceMessage, sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t), + NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + *PacketLength = (uint16_t)le32_to_cpu(DeviceMessage.DataLength); + + Pipe_Discard_Stream(le32_to_cpu(DeviceMessage.DataOffset) - + (sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t) - sizeof(RNDIS_Message_Header_t)), + NULL); + + Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(Buffer, *PacketLength, NULL); + + if (!(Pipe_BytesInPipe())) + Pipe_ClearIN(); + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +uint8_t RNDIS_Host_SendPacket(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t PacketLength) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(RNDISInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + + RNDIS_Packet_Message_t DeviceMessage; + + memset(&DeviceMessage, 0, sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t)); + DeviceMessage.MessageType = CPU_TO_LE32(REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_MSG); + DeviceMessage.MessageLength = CPU_TO_LE32(sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t) + PacketLength); + DeviceMessage.DataOffset = CPU_TO_LE32(sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t) - sizeof(RNDIS_Message_Header_t)); + DeviceMessage.DataLength = cpu_to_le32(PacketLength); + + Pipe_SelectPipe(RNDISInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(&DeviceMessage, sizeof(RNDIS_Packet_Message_t), + NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + { + return ErrorCode; + } + + Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(Buffer, PacketLength, NULL); + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/RNDISClassHost.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/RNDISClassHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bddbc247a8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/RNDISClassHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,270 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Host mode driver for the library USB RNDIS Class driver. + * + * Host mode driver for the library USB RNDIS Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassRNDIS + * \defgroup Group_USBClassRNDISHost RNDIS Class Host Mode Driver + * + * \section Sec_USBClassRNDISHost_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/RNDISClassHost.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassRNDISHost_ModDescription Module Description + * Host Mode USB Class driver framework interface, for the Microsoft RNDIS Ethernet + * USB Class driver. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __RNDIS_CLASS_HOST_H__ +#define __RNDIS_CLASS_HOST_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../USB.h" + #include "../Common/RNDISClassCommon.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_RNDIS_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief RNDIS Class Host Mode Configuration and State Structure. + * + * Class state structure. An instance of this structure should be made within the user application, + * and passed to each of the RNDIS class driver functions as the \c RNDISInterfaceInfo parameter. This + * stores each RNDIS interface's configuration and state information. + */ + typedef struct + { + struct + { + USB_Pipe_Table_t DataINPipe; /**< Data IN Pipe configuration table. */ + USB_Pipe_Table_t DataOUTPipe; /**< Data OUT Pipe configuration table. */ + USB_Pipe_Table_t NotificationPipe; /**< Notification IN Pipe configuration table. */ + + uint32_t HostMaxPacketSize; /**< Maximum size of a packet which can be buffered by the host. */ + } Config; /**< Config data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>must</b> be set or the interface will fail to enumerate and operate correctly. + */ + struct + { + bool IsActive; /**< Indicates if the current interface instance is connected to an attached device, valid + * after \ref RNDIS_Host_ConfigurePipes() is called and the Host state machine is in the + * Configured state. + */ + uint8_t ControlInterfaceNumber; /**< Interface index of the RNDIS control interface within the attached device. */ + + uint32_t DeviceMaxPacketSize; /**< Maximum size of a packet which can be buffered by the attached RNDIS device. */ + + uint32_t RequestID; /**< Request ID counter to give a unique ID for each command/response pair. */ + } State; /**< State data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>may</b> be set to initial values, but may also be ignored to default to sane values when + * the interface is enumerated. + */ + } USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t; + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible error codes returned by the \ref RNDIS_Host_ConfigurePipes() function. */ + enum RNDIS_Host_EnumerationFailure_ErrorCodes_t + { + RNDIS_ENUMERROR_NoError = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully. */ + RNDIS_ENUMERROR_InvalidConfigDescriptor = 1, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor. */ + RNDIS_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 2, /**< A compatible RNDIS interface was not found in the device's Configuration Descriptor. */ + RNDIS_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed = 3, /**< One or more pipes for the specified interface could not be configured correctly. */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Host interface configuration routine, to configure a given RNDIS host interface instance using the Configuration + * Descriptor read from an attached USB device. This function automatically updates the given RNDIS Host instance's + * state values and configures the pipes required to communicate with the interface if it is found within the device. + * This should be called once after the stack has enumerated the attached device, while the host state machine is in + * the Addressed state. + * + * \param[in,out] RNDISInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an RNDIS Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] ConfigDescriptorSize Length of the attached device's Configuration Descriptor. + * \param[in] ConfigDescriptorData Pointer to a buffer containing the attached device's Configuration Descriptor. + * + * \return A value from the \ref RNDIS_Host_EnumerationFailure_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t RNDIS_Host_ConfigurePipes(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize, + void* ConfigDescriptorData) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /** Sends a RNDIS KEEPALIVE command to the device, to ensure that it does not enter standby mode after periods + * of long inactivity. + * + * \param[in,out] RNDISInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an RNDIS Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum or \ref RNDIS_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED if the device returned a + * logical command failure. + */ + uint8_t RNDIS_Host_SendKeepAlive(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Initializes the attached RNDIS device's RNDIS interface. This should be called after the device's pipes have been + * configured via the call to \ref RNDIS_Host_ConfigurePipes(). + * + * \param[in,out] RNDISInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an RNDIS Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum or \ref RNDIS_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED if the + * device returned a logical command failure. + */ + uint8_t RNDIS_Host_InitializeDevice(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sets a given RNDIS property of an attached RNDIS device. + * + * \param[in,out] RNDISInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an RNDIS Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] Oid OID number of the parameter to set. + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to where the property data is to be sourced from. + * \param[in] Length Length in bytes of the property data to sent to the device. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum or \ref RNDIS_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED if the + * device returned a logical command failure. + */ + uint8_t RNDIS_Host_SetRNDISProperty(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t Oid, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /** Gets a given RNDIS property of an attached RNDIS device. + * + * \param[in,out] RNDISInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an RNDIS Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] Oid OID number of the parameter to get. + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to where the property data is to be written to. + * \param[in] MaxLength Length in bytes of the destination buffer size. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum or \ref RNDIS_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED if the + * device returned a logical command failure. + */ + uint8_t RNDIS_Host_QueryRNDISProperty(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t Oid, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t MaxLength) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /** Determines if a packet is currently waiting for the host to read in and process. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] RNDISInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an RNDIS Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if a packet is waiting to be read in by the host, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool RNDIS_Host_IsPacketReceived(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Retrieves the next pending packet from the device, discarding the remainder of the RNDIS packet header to leave + * only the packet contents for processing by the host in the nominated buffer. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] RNDISInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an RNDIS Class host configuration and state. + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to a buffer where the packer data is to be written to. + * \param[out] PacketLength Pointer to where the length in bytes of the read packet is to be stored. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t RNDIS_Host_ReadPacket(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + void* Buffer, + uint16_t* const PacketLength) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /** Sends the given packet to the attached RNDIS device, after adding a RNDIS packet message header. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] RNDISInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an RNDIS Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to a buffer where the packer data is to be read from. + * \param[in] PacketLength Length in bytes of the packet to send. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t RNDIS_Host_SendPacket(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t PacketLength) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** General management task for a given RNDIS host class interface, required for the correct operation of the interface. This should + * be called frequently in the main program loop, before the master USB management task \ref USB_USBTask(). + * + * \param[in,out] RNDISInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing an RNDIS Class host configuration and state. + */ + static inline void RNDIS_Host_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void RNDIS_Host_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo) + { + (void)RNDISInterfaceInfo; + } + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_RNDIS_HOST_C) + static uint8_t RNDIS_SendEncapsulatedCommand(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + static uint8_t RNDIS_GetEncapsulatedResponse(USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t* const RNDISInterfaceInfo, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + static uint8_t DCOMP_RNDIS_Host_NextRNDISControlInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static uint8_t DCOMP_RNDIS_Host_NextRNDISDataInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static uint8_t DCOMP_RNDIS_Host_NextRNDISInterfaceEndpoint(void* const CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + #endif + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/StillImageClassHost.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/StillImageClassHost.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ef33d9be40 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/StillImageClassHost.c @@ -0,0 +1,436 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../../Core/USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_SI_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_STILLIMAGE_HOST_C +#include "StillImageClassHost.h" + +uint8_t SI_Host_ConfigurePipes(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo, + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize, + void* ConfigDescriptorData) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EventsEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* StillImageInterface = NULL; + + memset(&SIInterfaceInfo->State, 0x00, sizeof(SIInterfaceInfo->State)); + + if (DESCRIPTOR_TYPE(ConfigDescriptorData) != DTYPE_Configuration) + return SI_ENUMERROR_InvalidConfigDescriptor; + + while (!(DataINEndpoint) || !(DataOUTEndpoint) || !(EventsEndpoint)) + { + if (!(StillImageInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_SI_Host_NextSIInterfaceEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&ConfigDescriptorSize, &ConfigDescriptorData, + DCOMP_SI_Host_NextSIInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + return SI_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + StillImageInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + DataINEndpoint = NULL; + DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + EventsEndpoint = NULL; + + continue; + } + + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigDescriptorData, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + { + if ((EndpointData->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK) == EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT) + EventsEndpoint = EndpointData; + else + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + else + { + DataOUTEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + } + + SIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize); + SIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.EndpointAddress = DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + SIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + + SIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointSize); + SIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.EndpointAddress = DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + SIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_BULK; + + SIInterfaceInfo->Config.EventsPipe.Size = le16_to_cpu(EventsEndpoint->EndpointSize); + SIInterfaceInfo->Config.EventsPipe.EndpointAddress = EventsEndpoint->EndpointAddress; + SIInterfaceInfo->Config.EventsPipe.Type = EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&SIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe, 1))) + return SI_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&SIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe, 1))) + return SI_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(&SIInterfaceInfo->Config.EventsPipe, 1))) + return SI_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed; + + SIInterfaceInfo->State.InterfaceNumber = StillImageInterface->InterfaceNumber; + SIInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive = true; + + return SI_ENUMERROR_NoError; +} + +uint8_t DCOMP_SI_Host_NextSIInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + if ((Interface->Class == SI_CSCP_StillImageClass) && + (Interface->SubClass == SI_CSCP_StillImageSubclass) && + (Interface->Protocol == SI_CSCP_BulkOnlyProtocol)) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +uint8_t DCOMP_SI_Host_NextSIInterfaceEndpoint(void* const CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* Endpoint = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + uint8_t EndpointType = (Endpoint->Attributes & EP_TYPE_MASK); + + if (((EndpointType == EP_TYPE_BULK) || (EndpointType == EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT)) && + (!(Pipe_IsEndpointBound(Endpoint->EndpointAddress)))) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +uint8_t SI_Host_SendBlockHeader(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo, + PIMA_Container_t* const PIMAHeader) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(SIInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + if (SIInterfaceInfo->State.IsSessionOpen) + PIMAHeader->TransactionID = cpu_to_le32(SIInterfaceInfo->State.TransactionID++); + + Pipe_SelectPipe(SIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(PIMAHeader, PIMA_COMMAND_SIZE(0), NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + uint8_t ParamBytes = (PIMAHeader->DataLength - PIMA_COMMAND_SIZE(0)); + + if (ParamBytes) + { + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(&PIMAHeader->Params, ParamBytes, NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + } + + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +uint8_t SI_Host_ReceiveBlockHeader(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo, + PIMA_Container_t* const PIMAHeader) +{ + uint16_t TimeoutMSRem = SI_COMMAND_DATA_TIMEOUT_MS; + uint16_t PreviousFrameNumber = USB_Host_GetFrameNumber(); + + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(SIInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(SIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + while (!(Pipe_IsINReceived())) + { + uint16_t CurrentFrameNumber = USB_Host_GetFrameNumber(); + + if (CurrentFrameNumber != PreviousFrameNumber) + { + PreviousFrameNumber = CurrentFrameNumber; + + if (!(TimeoutMSRem--)) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_Timeout; + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + Pipe_SelectPipe(SIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (Pipe_IsStalled()) + { + USB_Host_ClearEndpointStall(Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress()); + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_PipeStalled; + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + Pipe_SelectPipe(SIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (Pipe_IsStalled()) + { + USB_Host_ClearEndpointStall(Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress()); + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_PipeStalled; + } + + if (USB_HostState == HOST_STATE_Unattached) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + } + + Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(PIMAHeader, PIMA_COMMAND_SIZE(0), NULL); + + if (PIMAHeader->Type == CPU_TO_LE16(PIMA_CONTAINER_ResponseBlock)) + { + uint8_t ParamBytes = (PIMAHeader->DataLength - PIMA_COMMAND_SIZE(0)); + + if (ParamBytes) + Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(&PIMAHeader->Params, ParamBytes, NULL); + + Pipe_ClearIN(); + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +uint8_t SI_Host_SendData(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo, + const void* Buffer, + const uint16_t Bytes) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(SIInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(SIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataOUTPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(Buffer, Bytes, NULL); + + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return ErrorCode; +} + +uint8_t SI_Host_ReadData(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t Bytes) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(SIInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(SIInterfaceInfo->Config.DataINPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + ErrorCode = Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(Buffer, Bytes, NULL); + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return ErrorCode; +} + +bool SI_Host_IsEventReceived(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo) +{ + bool IsEventReceived = false; + + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(SIInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return false; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(SIInterfaceInfo->Config.EventsPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + IsEventReceived = true; + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return IsEventReceived; +} + +uint8_t SI_Host_ReceiveEventHeader(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo, + PIMA_Container_t* const PIMAHeader) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(SIInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(SIInterfaceInfo->Config.EventsPipe.Address); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + ErrorCode = Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(PIMAHeader, sizeof(PIMA_Container_t), NULL); + + Pipe_ClearIN(); + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return ErrorCode; +} + +uint8_t SI_Host_OpenSession(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(SIInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + SIInterfaceInfo->State.TransactionID = 0; + SIInterfaceInfo->State.IsSessionOpen = false; + + PIMA_Container_t PIMABlock = (PIMA_Container_t) + { + .DataLength = CPU_TO_LE32(PIMA_COMMAND_SIZE(1)), + .Type = CPU_TO_LE16(PIMA_CONTAINER_CommandBlock), + .Code = CPU_TO_LE16(0x1002), + .Params = {CPU_TO_LE32(1)}, + }; + + if ((ErrorCode = SI_Host_SendBlockHeader(SIInterfaceInfo, &PIMABlock)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + if ((ErrorCode = SI_Host_ReceiveBlockHeader(SIInterfaceInfo, &PIMABlock)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + if ((PIMABlock.Type != CPU_TO_LE16(PIMA_CONTAINER_ResponseBlock)) || (PIMABlock.Code != CPU_TO_LE16(0x2001))) + return SI_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED; + + SIInterfaceInfo->State.IsSessionOpen = true; + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +uint8_t SI_Host_CloseSession(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(SIInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + PIMA_Container_t PIMABlock = (PIMA_Container_t) + { + .DataLength = CPU_TO_LE32(PIMA_COMMAND_SIZE(1)), + .Type = CPU_TO_LE16(PIMA_CONTAINER_CommandBlock), + .Code = CPU_TO_LE16(0x1003), + .Params = {CPU_TO_LE32(1)}, + }; + + if ((ErrorCode = SI_Host_SendBlockHeader(SIInterfaceInfo, &PIMABlock)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + if ((ErrorCode = SI_Host_ReceiveBlockHeader(SIInterfaceInfo, &PIMABlock)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + SIInterfaceInfo->State.IsSessionOpen = false; + + if ((PIMABlock.Type != CPU_TO_LE16(PIMA_CONTAINER_ResponseBlock)) || (PIMABlock.Code != CPU_TO_LE16(0x2001))) + return SI_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED; + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +uint8_t SI_Host_SendCommand(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo, + const uint16_t Operation, + const uint8_t TotalParams, + uint32_t* const Params) +{ + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(SIInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + PIMA_Container_t PIMABlock = (PIMA_Container_t) + { + .DataLength = cpu_to_le32(PIMA_COMMAND_SIZE(TotalParams)), + .Type = CPU_TO_LE16(PIMA_CONTAINER_CommandBlock), + .Code = cpu_to_le16(Operation), + }; + + memcpy(&PIMABlock.Params, Params, sizeof(uint32_t) * TotalParams); + + if ((ErrorCode = SI_Host_SendBlockHeader(SIInterfaceInfo, &PIMABlock)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +uint8_t SI_Host_ReceiveResponse(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + PIMA_Container_t PIMABlock; + + if ((USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) || !(SIInterfaceInfo->State.IsActive)) + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + + if ((ErrorCode = SI_Host_ReceiveBlockHeader(SIInterfaceInfo, &PIMABlock)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + return ErrorCode; + + if ((PIMABlock.Type != CPU_TO_LE16(PIMA_CONTAINER_ResponseBlock)) || (PIMABlock.Code != CPU_TO_LE16(0x2001))) + return SI_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED; + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/StillImageClassHost.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/StillImageClassHost.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ababdb09a6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/StillImageClassHost.h @@ -0,0 +1,317 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Host mode driver for the library USB Still Image Class driver. + * + * Host mode driver for the library USB Still Image Class driver. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB module driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassSI + * \defgroup Group_USBClassStillImageHost Still Image Class Host Mode Driver + * + * \section Sec_USBClassStillImageHost_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/StillImageClassHost.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassStillImageHost_ModDescription Module Description + * Host Mode USB Class driver framework interface, for the Still Image USB Class driver. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __SI_CLASS_HOST_H__ +#define __SI_CLASS_HOST_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../USB.h" + #include "../Common/StillImageClassCommon.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_SI_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Error code for some Still Image Host functions, indicating a logical (and not hardware) error. */ + #define SI_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED 0x80 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief Still Image Class Host Mode Configuration and State Structure. + * + * Class state structure. An instance of this structure should be made within the user application, + * and passed to each of the Still Image class driver functions as the \c SIInterfaceInfo parameter. This + * stores each Still Image interface's configuration and state information. + */ + typedef struct + { + struct + { + USB_Pipe_Table_t DataINPipe; /**< Data IN Pipe configuration table. */ + USB_Pipe_Table_t DataOUTPipe; /**< Data OUT Pipe configuration table. */ + USB_Pipe_Table_t EventsPipe; /**< Event notification IN Pipe configuration table. */ + } Config; /**< Config data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>must</b> be set or the interface will fail to enumerate and operate correctly. + */ + struct + { + bool IsActive; /**< Indicates if the current interface instance is connected to an attached device, valid + * after \ref SI_Host_ConfigurePipes() is called and the Host state machine is in the + * Configured state. + */ + uint8_t InterfaceNumber; /**< Interface index of the Still Image interface within the attached device. */ + + bool IsSessionOpen; /**< Indicates if a PIMA session is currently open with the attached device. */ + uint32_t TransactionID; /**< Transaction ID for the next transaction to send to the device. */ + } State; /**< State data for the USB class interface within the device. All elements in this section + * <b>may</b> be set to initial values, but may also be ignored to default to sane values when + * the interface is enumerated. + */ + } USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t; + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible error codes returned by the \ref SI_Host_ConfigurePipes() function. */ + enum SI_Host_EnumerationFailure_ErrorCodes_t + { + SI_ENUMERROR_NoError = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully. */ + SI_ENUMERROR_InvalidConfigDescriptor = 1, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor. */ + SI_ENUMERROR_NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 2, /**< A compatible Still Image interface was not found in the device's + * Configuration Descriptor. + */ + SI_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigurationFailed = 3, /**< One or more pipes for the specified interface could not be configured correctly. */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Host interface configuration routine, to configure a given Still Image host interface instance using the + * Configuration Descriptor read from an attached USB device. This function automatically updates the given Still + * Image Host instance's state values and configures the pipes required to communicate with the interface if it is + * found within the device. This should be called once after the stack has enumerated the attached device, while + * the host state machine is in the Addressed state. + * + * \param[in,out] SIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Still Image Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] ConfigDescriptorSize Length of the attached device's Configuration Descriptor. + * \param[in] ConfigDescriptorData Pointer to a buffer containing the attached device's Configuration Descriptor. + * + * \return A value from the \ref SI_Host_EnumerationFailure_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t SI_Host_ConfigurePipes(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo, + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize, + void* ConfigDescriptorData) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /** Opens a new PIMA session with the attached device. This should be used before any session-orientated PIMA commands + * are issued to the device. Only one session can be open at the one time. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] SIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Still Image Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum, or \ref SI_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED if the device + * returned a logical command failure. + */ + uint8_t SI_Host_OpenSession(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Closes an already opened PIMA session with the attached device. This should be used after all session-orientated + * PIMA commands have been issued to the device. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] SIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Still Image Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum, or \ref SI_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED if the device + * returned a logical command failure. + */ + uint8_t SI_Host_CloseSession(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sends a raw PIMA block header to the device, filling out the transaction ID automatically. This can be used to send + * arbitrary PIMA blocks to the device with or without parameters. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] SIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Still Image Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] PIMAHeader Pointer to a PIMA container structure that is to be sent. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t SI_Host_SendBlockHeader(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo, + PIMA_Container_t* const PIMAHeader) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Receives a raw PIMA block header from the device. This can be used to receive arbitrary PIMA blocks from the device with + * or without parameters. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] SIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Still Image Class host configuration and state. + * \param[out] PIMAHeader Pointer to a PIMA container structure where the received block is to be stored. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t SI_Host_ReceiveBlockHeader(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo, + PIMA_Container_t* const PIMAHeader) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Sends a given PIMA command to the attached device, filling out the PIMA command header's Transaction ID automatically. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] SIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Still Image Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] Operation PIMA operation code to issue to the device. + * \param[in] TotalParams Total number of 32-bit parameters to send to the device in the issued command block. + * \param[in] Params Pointer to an array of 32-bit values containing the parameters to send in the command block. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum, or \ref SI_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED if the device + * returned a logical command failure. + */ + uint8_t SI_Host_SendCommand(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo, + const uint16_t Operation, + const uint8_t TotalParams, + uint32_t* const Params) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Receives and checks a response block from the attached Still Image device, once a command has been issued and all data + * associated with the command has been transferred. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] SIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Still Image Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum, or \ref SI_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED if the device + * returned a logical command failure. + */ + uint8_t SI_Host_ReceiveResponse(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Indicates if the device has issued a PIMA event block to the host via the asynchronous events pipe. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] SIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Still Image Class host configuration and state. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if an event is waiting to be read, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool SI_Host_IsEventReceived(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Receives an asynchronous event block from the device via the asynchronous events pipe. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] SIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Still Image Class host configuration and state. + * \param[out] PIMAHeader Pointer to a PIMA container structure where the event should be stored. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum, or \ref SI_ERROR_LOGICAL_CMD_FAILED if the device + * returned a logical command failure. + */ + uint8_t SI_Host_ReceiveEventHeader(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo, + PIMA_Container_t* const PIMAHeader) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Sends arbitrary data to the attached device, for use in the data phase of PIMA commands which require data + * transfer beyond the regular PIMA command block parameters. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] SIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Still Image Class host configuration and state. + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to a buffer where the data to send has been stored. + * \param[in] Bytes Length in bytes of the data in the buffer to send to the attached device. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t SI_Host_SendData(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo, + const void* Buffer, + const uint16_t Bytes) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Receives arbitrary data from the attached device, for use in the data phase of PIMA commands which require data + * transfer beyond the regular PIMA command block parameters. + * + * \pre This function must only be called when the Host state machine is in the \ref HOST_STATE_Configured state or the + * call will fail. + * + * \param[in,out] SIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Still Image Class host configuration and state. + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to a buffer where the received data is to be stored. + * \param[in] Bytes Length in bytes of the data to read. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t SI_Host_ReadData(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo, + void* Buffer, + const uint16_t Bytes) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** General management task for a given Still Image host class interface, required for the correct operation of the + * interface. This should be called frequently in the main program loop, before the master USB management task + * \ref USB_USBTask(). + * + * \param[in,out] SIInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Still Image Class host configuration and state. + */ + static inline void SI_Host_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void SI_Host_USBTask(USB_ClassInfo_SI_Host_t* const SIInterfaceInfo) + { + (void)SIInterfaceInfo; + } + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define SI_COMMAND_DATA_TIMEOUT_MS 10000 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_STILLIMAGE_HOST_C) + static uint8_t DCOMP_SI_Host_NextSIInterface(void* const CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static uint8_t DCOMP_SI_Host_NextSIInterfaceEndpoint(void* const CurrentDescriptor) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + #endif + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/MIDIClass.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/MIDIClass.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a35ae13aa0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/MIDIClass.h @@ -0,0 +1,84 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Master include file for the library USB MIDI Class driver. + * + * Master include file for the library USB MIDI Class driver, for both host and device modes, where available. + * + * This file should be included in all user projects making use of this optional class driver, instead of + * including any headers in the USB/ClassDriver/Device, USB/ClassDriver/Host or USB/ClassDriver/Common subdirectories. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassDrivers + * \defgroup Group_USBClassMIDI MIDI Class Driver + * \brief USB class driver for the USB-IF MIDI class standard. + * + * \section Sec_USBClassMIDI_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MIDIClassDevice.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MIDIClassHost.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassMIDI_ModDescription Module Description + * MIDI Class Driver module. This module contains an internal implementation of the USB MIDI Class, for both Device + * and Host USB modes. User applications can use this class driver instead of implementing the MIDI class manually + * via the low-level LUFA APIs. + * + * This module is designed to simplify the user code by exposing only the required interface needed to interface with + * Hosts or Devices using the USB MIDI Class. + * + * \note The USB MIDI class is actually a special case of the regular Audio class, thus this module depends on + * structure definitions from the \ref Group_USBClassAudioDevice class driver module. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _MIDI_CLASS_H_ +#define _MIDI_CLASS_H_ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_MIDI_DRIVER + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../Core/USBMode.h" + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + #include "Device/MIDIClassDevice.h" + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + #include "Host/MIDIClassHost.h" + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/MassStorageClass.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/MassStorageClass.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fa41fbf817 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/MassStorageClass.h @@ -0,0 +1,81 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Master include file for the library USB Mass Storage Class driver. + * + * Master include file for the library USB Mass Storage Class driver, for both host and device modes, where available. + * + * This file should be included in all user projects making use of this optional class driver, instead of + * including any headers in the USB/ClassDriver/Device, USB/ClassDriver/Host or USB/ClassDriver/Common subdirectories. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassDrivers + * \defgroup Group_USBClassMS Mass Storage Class Driver + * \brief USB class driver for the USB-IF Bulk-Only Transport Mass Storage class standard. + * + * \section Sec_USBClassMS_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MassStorageClassDevice.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MassStorageClassHost.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassMS_ModDescription Module Description + * Mass Storage Class Driver module. This module contains an internal implementation of the USB Mass Storage Class, for both + * Device and Host USB modes. User applications can use this class driver instead of implementing the Mass Storage class + * manually via the low-level LUFA APIs. + * + * This module is designed to simplify the user code by exposing only the required interface needed to interface with + * Hosts or Devices using the USB Mass Storage Class. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _MS_CLASS_H_ +#define _MS_CLASS_H_ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_MS_DRIVER + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../Core/USBMode.h" + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + #include "Device/MassStorageClassDevice.h" + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + #include "Host/MassStorageClassHost.h" + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/PrinterClass.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/PrinterClass.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..78ad52068a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/PrinterClass.h @@ -0,0 +1,83 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Master include file for the library USB Printer Class driver. + * + * Master include file for the library USB Printer Class driver, for both host and device modes, where available. + * + * This file should be included in all user projects making use of this optional class driver, instead of + * including any headers in the USB/ClassDriver/Device, USB/ClassDriver/Host or USB/ClassDriver/Common subdirectories. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassDrivers + * \defgroup Group_USBClassPrinter Printer Class Driver + * \brief USB class driver for the USB-IF Printer class standard. + * + * \section Sec_USBClassPrinter_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/PrinterClassDevice.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/PrinterClassHost.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassPrinter_ModDescription Module Description + * Printer Class Driver module. This module contains an internal implementation of the USB Printer Class, for the base + * USB Printer transport layer for USB Host mode only. Note that printers are free to implement whatever printer language + * they choose on top of this (e.g. Postscript), and so this driver exposes low level data transport functions only rather + * than high level raster or text functions. User applications can use this class driver instead of implementing the Printer + * class manually via the low-level LUFA APIs. + * + * This module is designed to simplify the user code by exposing only the required interface needed to interface with + * Devices using the USB Printer Class. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _PRINTER_CLASS_H_ +#define _PRINTER_CLASS_H_ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_PRINTER_DRIVER + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../Core/USBMode.h" + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + #include "Device/PrinterClassDevice.h" + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + #include "Host/PrinterClassHost.h" + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/RNDISClass.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/RNDISClass.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..07b4f56270 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/RNDISClass.h @@ -0,0 +1,81 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Master include file for the library USB RNDIS Class driver. + * + * Master include file for the library USB RNDIS Class driver, for both host and device modes, where available. + * + * This file should be included in all user projects making use of this optional class driver, instead of + * including any headers in the USB/ClassDriver/Device, USB/ClassDriver/Host or USB/ClassDriver/Common subdirectories. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassDrivers + * \defgroup Group_USBClassRNDIS RNDIS (Networking) Class Driver + * \brief USB class driver for the Microsoft Remote Network Driver Interface Specification (RNDIS) class standard. + * + * \section Sec_USBClassRNDIS_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Device/RNDISClassDevice.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/RNDISClassHost.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassRNDIS_ModDescription Module Description + * RNDIS Class Driver module. This module contains an internal implementation of the Microsoft USB RNDIS Networking + * Class, for both Device and Host USB modes. User applications can use this class driver instead of implementing the + * RNDIS class manually via the low-level LUFA APIs. + * + * This module is designed to simplify the user code by exposing only the required interface needed to interface with + * Hosts using the USB RNDIS Class. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _RNDIS_CLASS_H_ +#define _RNDIS_CLASS_H_ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_RNDIS_DRIVER + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../Core/USBMode.h" + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + #include "Device/RNDISClassDevice.h" + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + #include "Host/RNDISClassHost.h" + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/StillImageClass.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/StillImageClass.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7cb8b4fcf6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/StillImageClass.h @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Master include file for the library USB Still Image Class driver. + * + * Master include file for the library USB Still Image Class driver, for both host and device modes, where available. + * + * This file should be included in all user projects making use of this optional class driver, instead of + * including any headers in the USB/ClassDriver/Device, USB/ClassDriver/Host or USB/ClassDriver/Common subdirectories. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBClassDrivers + * \defgroup Group_USBClassSI Still Image Class Driver + * \brief USB class driver for the USB-IF Still Image (PIMA-compliant) class standard. + * + * \section Sec_USBClassSI_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Host/StillImageClassHost.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USBClassSI_ModDescription Module Description + * Still Image Class Driver module. This module contains an internal implementation of the USB Still Image Class, + * for USB Host mode only. User applications can use this class driver instead of implementing the Still Image class + * manually via the low-level LUFA APIs. + * + * This module is designed to simplify the user code by exposing only the required interface needed to interface with + * Devices using the USB Still Image Class. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _SI_CLASS_H_ +#define _SI_CLASS_H_ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_SI_DRIVER + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../Core/USBMode.h" + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + #include "Host/StillImageClassHost.h" + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Device_AVR8.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Device_AVR8.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f972b0bcc5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Device_AVR8.c @@ -0,0 +1,57 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + +#include "../Device.h" + +void USB_Device_SendRemoteWakeup(void) +{ + if (!(USB_Options & USB_OPT_MANUAL_PLL)) + { + USB_PLL_On(); + while (!(USB_PLL_IsReady())); + } + + USB_CLK_Unfreeze(); + + UDCON |= (1 << RMWKUP); + while (UDCON & (1 << RMWKUP)); +} + +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Device_AVR8.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Device_AVR8.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..69f9be593e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Device_AVR8.h @@ -0,0 +1,269 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Device definitions for the AVR8 microcontrollers. + * \copydetails Group_Device_AVR8 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Device + * \defgroup Group_Device_AVR8 Device Management (AVR8) + * \brief USB Device definitions for the AVR8 microcontrollers. + * + * Architecture specific USB Device definitions for the Atmel 8-bit AVR microcontrollers. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __USBDEVICE_AVR8_H__ +#define __USBDEVICE_AVR8_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../USBController.h" + #include "../StdDescriptors.h" + #include "../USBInterrupt.h" + #include "../Endpoint.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + #if (defined(USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS) && defined(USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS)) + #error USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS and USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS are mutually exclusive. + #endif + + #if (defined(USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS) && defined(USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS)) + #error USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS and USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS are mutually exclusive. + #endif + + #if (defined(USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS) && defined(USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS)) + #error USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS and USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS are mutually exclusive. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** \name USB Device Mode Option Masks */ + //@{ + #if defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Mask for the Options parameter of the \ref USB_Init() function. This indicates that the + * USB interface should be initialized in low speed (1.5Mb/s) mode. + * + * \note Low Speed mode is not available on all USB AVR models. + * \n + * + * \note Restrictions apply on the number, size and type of endpoints which can be used + * when running in low speed mode - please refer to the USB 2.0 specification. + */ + #define USB_DEVICE_OPT_LOWSPEED (1 << 0) + #endif + + /** Mask for the Options parameter of the \ref USB_Init() function. This indicates that the + * USB interface should be initialized in full speed (12Mb/s) mode. + */ + #define USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED (0 << 0) + //@} + + #if (!defined(NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL) && \ + (defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || \ + defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_2_AVR) || \ + defined(__DOXYGEN__))) + /** String descriptor index for the device's unique serial number string descriptor within the device. + * This unique serial number is used by the host to associate resources to the device (such as drivers or COM port + * number allocations) to a device regardless of the port it is plugged in to on the host. Some microcontrollers contain + * a unique serial number internally, and setting the device descriptors serial number string index to this value + * will cause it to use the internal serial number. + * + * On unsupported devices, this will evaluate to \ref NO_DESCRIPTOR and so will force the host to create a pseudo-serial + * number for the device. + */ + #define USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL 0xDC + + /** Length of the device's unique internal serial number, in bits, if present on the selected microcontroller + * model. + */ + #define INTERNAL_SERIAL_LENGTH_BITS 80 + + /** Start address of the internal serial number, in the appropriate address space, if present on the selected microcontroller + * model. + */ + #define INTERNAL_SERIAL_START_ADDRESS 0x0E + #else + #define USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL NO_DESCRIPTOR + + #define INTERNAL_SERIAL_LENGTH_BITS 0 + #define INTERNAL_SERIAL_START_ADDRESS 0 + #endif + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Sends a Remote Wakeup request to the host. This signals to the host that the device should + * be taken out of suspended mode, and communications should resume. + * + * Typically, this is implemented so that HID devices (mice, keyboards, etc.) can wake up the + * host computer when the host has suspended all USB devices to enter a low power state. + * + * \attention This function should only be used if the device has indicated to the host that it + * supports the Remote Wakeup feature in the device descriptors, and should only be + * issued if the host is currently allowing remote wakeup events from the device (i.e., + * the \ref USB_Device_RemoteWakeupEnabled flag is set). When the \c NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP + * compile time option is used, this function is unavailable. + * \n\n + * + * \attention The USB clock must be running for this function to operate. If the stack is initialized with + * the \ref USB_OPT_MANUAL_PLL option enabled, the user must ensure that the PLL is running + * before attempting to call this function. + * + * \see \ref Group_StdDescriptors for more information on the RMWAKEUP feature and device descriptors. + */ + void USB_Device_SendRemoteWakeup(void); + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Returns the current USB frame number, when in device mode. Every millisecond the USB bus is active (i.e. enumerated to a host) + * the frame number is incremented by one. + * + * \return Current USB frame number from the USB controller. + */ + static inline uint16_t USB_Device_GetFrameNumber(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint16_t USB_Device_GetFrameNumber(void) + { + return UDFNUM; + } + + #if !defined(NO_SOF_EVENTS) + /** Enables the device mode Start Of Frame events. When enabled, this causes the + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame() event to fire once per millisecond, synchronized to the USB bus, + * at the start of each USB frame when enumerated in device mode. + * + * \note This function is not available when the \c NO_SOF_EVENTS compile time token is defined. + */ + static inline void USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(void) + { + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_SOFI); + } + + /** Disables the device mode Start Of Frame events. When disabled, this stops the firing of the + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame() event when enumerated in device mode. + * + * \note This function is not available when the \c NO_SOF_EVENTS compile time token is defined. + */ + static inline void USB_Device_DisableSOFEvents(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Device_DisableSOFEvents(void) + { + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_SOFI); + } + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if defined(USB_DEVICE_OPT_LOWSPEED) + static inline void USB_Device_SetLowSpeed(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Device_SetLowSpeed(void) + { + UDCON |= (1 << LSM); + } + + static inline void USB_Device_SetFullSpeed(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Device_SetFullSpeed(void) + { + UDCON &= ~(1 << LSM); + } + #endif + + static inline void USB_Device_SetDeviceAddress(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Device_SetDeviceAddress(const uint8_t Address) + { + UDADDR = (UDADDR & (1 << ADDEN)) | (Address & 0x7F); + } + + static inline void USB_Device_EnableDeviceAddress(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Device_EnableDeviceAddress(const uint8_t Address) + { + (void)Address; + + UDADDR |= (1 << ADDEN); + } + + static inline bool USB_Device_IsAddressSet(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline bool USB_Device_IsAddressSet(void) + { + return (UDADDR & (1 << ADDEN)); + } + + #if (USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL != NO_DESCRIPTOR) + static inline void USB_Device_GetSerialString(uint16_t* const UnicodeString) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void USB_Device_GetSerialString(uint16_t* const UnicodeString) + { + uint_reg_t CurrentGlobalInt = GetGlobalInterruptMask(); + GlobalInterruptDisable(); + + uint8_t SigReadAddress = INTERNAL_SERIAL_START_ADDRESS; + + for (uint8_t SerialCharNum = 0; SerialCharNum < (INTERNAL_SERIAL_LENGTH_BITS / 4); SerialCharNum++) + { + uint8_t SerialByte = boot_signature_byte_get(SigReadAddress); + + if (SerialCharNum & 0x01) + { + SerialByte >>= 4; + SigReadAddress++; + } + + SerialByte &= 0x0F; + + UnicodeString[SerialCharNum] = cpu_to_le16((SerialByte >= 10) ? + (('A' - 10) + SerialByte) : ('0' + SerialByte)); + } + + SetGlobalInterruptMask(CurrentGlobalInt); + } + #endif + + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/EndpointStream_AVR8.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/EndpointStream_AVR8.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8ffae15e19 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/EndpointStream_AVR8.c @@ -0,0 +1,275 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + +#include "EndpointStream_AVR8.h" + +#if !defined(CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE) +uint8_t Endpoint_Discard_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + uint16_t BytesInTransfer = 0; + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + Length -= *BytesProcessed; + + while (Length) + { + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + *BytesProcessed += BytesInTransfer; + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + } + else + { + Endpoint_Discard_8(); + + Length--; + BytesInTransfer++; + } + } + + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +uint8_t Endpoint_Null_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + uint16_t BytesInTransfer = 0; + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + Length -= *BytesProcessed; + + while (Length) + { + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + *BytesProcessed += BytesInTransfer; + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + } + else + { + Endpoint_Write_8(0); + + Length--; + BytesInTransfer++; + } + } + + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +/* The following abuses the C preprocessor in order to copy-paste common code with slight alterations, + * so that the code needs to be written once. It is a crude form of templating to reduce code maintenance. */ + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearIN() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(*BufferPtr) +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearIN() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(*BufferPtr) +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE void* +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearOUT() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) *BufferPtr = Endpoint_Read_8() +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_Stream_BE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE void* +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearOUT() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) *BufferPtr = Endpoint_Read_8() +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + +#if defined(ARCH_HAS_FLASH_ADDRESS_SPACE) + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_PStream_LE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* + #define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearIN() + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(pgm_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_PStream_BE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* + #define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearIN() + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(pgm_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" +#endif + +#if defined(ARCH_HAS_EEPROM_ADDRESS_SPACE) + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_EStream_LE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* + #define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearIN() + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(eeprom_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_EStream_BE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* + #define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearIN() + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(eeprom_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_EStream_LE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE void* + #define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearOUT() + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) eeprom_update_byte(BufferPtr, Endpoint_Read_8()) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_EStream_BE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE void* + #define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearOUT() + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) eeprom_update_byte(BufferPtr, Endpoint_Read_8()) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" +#endif + +#endif + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(*BufferPtr) +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_BE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(*BufferPtr) +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) *BufferPtr = Endpoint_Read_8() +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_BE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) *BufferPtr = Endpoint_Read_8() +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c" + +#if defined(ARCH_HAS_FLASH_ADDRESS_SPACE) + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Control_PStream_LE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(pgm_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Control_PStream_BE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(pgm_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c" +#endif + +#if defined(ARCH_HAS_EEPROM_ADDRESS_SPACE) + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Control_EStream_LE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(eeprom_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Control_EStream_BE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(eeprom_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_Control_EStream_LE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) eeprom_update_byte(BufferPtr, Endpoint_Read_8()) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_Control_EStream_BE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) eeprom_update_byte(BufferPtr, Endpoint_Read_8()) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c" +#endif + +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/EndpointStream_AVR8.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/EndpointStream_AVR8.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..80e78df1b4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/EndpointStream_AVR8.h @@ -0,0 +1,658 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Endpoint data stream transmission and reception management for the AVR8 microcontrollers. + * \copydetails Group_EndpointStreamRW_AVR8 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_EndpointStreamRW + * \defgroup Group_EndpointStreamRW_AVR8 Read/Write of Multi-Byte Streams (AVR8) + * \brief Endpoint data stream transmission and reception management for the Atmel AVR8 architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing of data streams from + * and to endpoints. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __ENDPOINT_STREAM_AVR8_H__ +#define __ENDPOINT_STREAM_AVR8_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../USBMode.h" + #include "../USBTask.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** \name Stream functions for null data */ + //@{ + + /** Reads and discards the given number of bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank, + * discarding fully read packets from the host as needed. The last packet is not automatically + * discarded once the remaining bytes has been read; the user is responsible for manually + * discarding the last packet from the host via the \ref Endpoint_ClearOUT() macro. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, + * failing or succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid + * storage location, the transfer will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time + * the endpoint bank becomes empty while there is still data to process (and after the current + * packet has been acknowledged) the BytesProcessed location will be updated with the total number + * of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed + * in the user code - to continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters + * and it will resume until the BytesProcessed value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Discard_Stream(512, NULL)) != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Discard_Stream(512, &BytesProcessed)) == ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note This routine should not be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to discard via the currently selected endpoint. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Discard_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed); + + /** Writes a given number of zeroed bytes to the currently selected endpoint's bank, sending + * full packets to the host as needed. The last packet is not automatically sent once the + * remaining bytes have been written; the user is responsible for manually sending the last + * packet to the host via the \ref Endpoint_ClearIN() macro. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, + * failing or succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid + * storage location, the transfer will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time + * the endpoint bank becomes full while there is still data to process (and after the current + * packet transmission has been initiated) the BytesProcessed location will be updated with the + * total number of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed + * in the user code - to continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters + * and it will resume until the BytesProcessed value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Null_Stream(512, NULL)) != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Null_Stream(512, &BytesProcessed)) == ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note This routine should not be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \param[in] Length Number of zero bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Null_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed); + + //@} + + /** \name Stream functions for RAM source/destination data */ + //@{ + + /** Writes the given number of bytes to the endpoint from the given buffer in little endian, + * sending full packets to the host as needed. The last packet filled is not automatically sent; + * the user is responsible for manually sending the last written packet to the host via the + * \ref Endpoint_ClearIN() macro. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, + * failing or succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid + * storage location, the transfer will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time + * the endpoint bank becomes full while there is still data to process (and after the current + * packet transmission has been initiated) the BytesProcessed location will be updated with the + * total number of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed + * in the user code - to continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters + * and it will resume until the BytesProcessed value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * NULL)) != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * &BytesProcessed)) == ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note This routine should not be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Writes the given number of bytes to the endpoint from the given buffer in big endian, + * sending full packets to the host as needed. The last packet filled is not automatically sent; + * the user is responsible for manually sending the last written packet to the host via the + * \ref Endpoint_ClearIN() macro. + * + * \note This routine should not be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads the given number of bytes from the endpoint from the given buffer in little endian, + * discarding fully read packets from the host as needed. The last packet is not automatically + * discarded once the remaining bytes has been read; the user is responsible for manually + * discarding the last packet from the host via the \ref Endpoint_ClearOUT() macro. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, + * failing or succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid + * storage location, the transfer will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time + * the endpoint bank becomes empty while there is still data to process (and after the current + * packet has been acknowledged) the BytesProcessed location will be updated with the total number + * of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed + * in the user code - to continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters + * and it will resume until the BytesProcessed value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * NULL)) != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * &BytesProcessed)) == ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note This routine should not be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads the given number of bytes from the endpoint from the given buffer in big endian, + * discarding fully read packets from the host as needed. The last packet is not automatically + * discarded once the remaining bytes has been read; the user is responsible for manually + * discarding the last packet from the host via the \ref Endpoint_ClearOUT() macro. + * + * \note This routine should not be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_Stream_BE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Writes the given number of bytes to the CONTROL type endpoint from the given buffer in little endian, + * sending full packets to the host as needed. The host OUT acknowledgement is not automatically cleared + * in both failure and success states; the user is responsible for manually clearing the status OUT packet + * to finalize the transfer's status stage via the \ref Endpoint_ClearOUT() macro. + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Writes the given number of bytes to the CONTROL type endpoint from the given buffer in big endian, + * sending full packets to the host as needed. The host OUT acknowledgement is not automatically cleared + * in both failure and success states; the user is responsible for manually clearing the status OUT packet + * to finalize the transfer's status stage via the \ref Endpoint_ClearOUT() macro. + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_BE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads the given number of bytes from the CONTROL endpoint from the given buffer in little endian, + * discarding fully read packets from the host as needed. The device IN acknowledgement is not + * automatically sent after success or failure states; the user is responsible for manually sending the + * status IN packet to finalize the transfer's status stage via the \ref Endpoint_ClearIN() macro. + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads the given number of bytes from the CONTROL endpoint from the given buffer in big endian, + * discarding fully read packets from the host as needed. The device IN acknowledgement is not + * automatically sent after success or failure states; the user is responsible for manually sending the + * status IN packet to finalize the transfer's status stage via the \ref Endpoint_ClearIN() macro. + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_BE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + //@} + + /** \name Stream functions for EEPROM source/destination data */ + //@{ + + /** EEPROM buffer source version of \ref Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(). + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_EStream_LE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** EEPROM buffer source version of \ref Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE(). + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_EStream_BE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** EEPROM buffer destination version of \ref Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(). + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to, located in EEPROM memory space. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_EStream_LE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** EEPROM buffer destination version of \ref Endpoint_Read_Stream_BE(). + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to, located in EEPROM memory space. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_EStream_BE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** EEPROM buffer source version of Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE. + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * \n\n + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Control_EStream_LE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** EEPROM buffer source version of \ref Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_BE(). + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * \n\n + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Control_EStream_BE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** EEPROM buffer source version of \ref Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE(). + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * \n\n + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_Control_EStream_LE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** EEPROM buffer source version of \ref Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_BE(). + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * \n\n + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_Control_EStream_BE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + //@} + + /** \name Stream functions for PROGMEM source/destination data */ + //@{ + + /** FLASH buffer source version of \ref Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(). + * + * \pre The FLASH data must be located in the first 64KB of FLASH for this function to work correctly. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_PStream_LE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** FLASH buffer source version of \ref Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE(). + * + * \pre The FLASH data must be located in the first 64KB of FLASH for this function to work correctly. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_PStream_BE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** FLASH buffer source version of \ref Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(). + * + * \pre The FLASH data must be located in the first 64KB of FLASH for this function to work correctly. + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * \n\n + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Control_PStream_LE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** FLASH buffer source version of \ref Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_BE(). + * + * \pre The FLASH data must be located in the first 64KB of FLASH for this function to work correctly. + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * \n\n + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Control_PStream_BE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + //@} + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Endpoint_AVR8.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Endpoint_AVR8.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..92cf8360de --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Endpoint_AVR8.c @@ -0,0 +1,201 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + +#include "../Endpoint.h" + +#if !defined(FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE) +uint8_t USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize = ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP_DEFAULT_SIZE; +#endif + +bool Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(const USB_Endpoint_Table_t* const Table, + const uint8_t Entries) +{ + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < Entries; i++) + { + if (!(Table[i].Address)) + continue; + + if (!(Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(Table[i].Address, Table[i].Type, Table[i].Size, Table[i].Banks))) + return false; + } + + return true; +} + +bool Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint_Prv(const uint8_t Number, + const uint8_t UECFG0XData, + const uint8_t UECFG1XData) +{ +#if defined(CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE) || defined(ORDERED_EP_CONFIG) + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(Number); + Endpoint_EnableEndpoint(); + + UECFG1X = 0; + UECFG0X = UECFG0XData; + UECFG1X = UECFG1XData; + + return Endpoint_IsConfigured(); +#else + for (uint8_t EPNum = Number; EPNum < ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS; EPNum++) + { + uint8_t UECFG0XTemp; + uint8_t UECFG1XTemp; + uint8_t UEIENXTemp; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(EPNum); + + if (EPNum == Number) + { + UECFG0XTemp = UECFG0XData; + UECFG1XTemp = UECFG1XData; + UEIENXTemp = 0; + } + else + { + UECFG0XTemp = UECFG0X; + UECFG1XTemp = UECFG1X; + UEIENXTemp = UEIENX; + } + + if (!(UECFG1XTemp & (1 << ALLOC))) + continue; + + Endpoint_DisableEndpoint(); + UECFG1X &= ~(1 << ALLOC); + + Endpoint_EnableEndpoint(); + UECFG0X = UECFG0XTemp; + UECFG1X = UECFG1XTemp; + UEIENX = UEIENXTemp; + + if (!(Endpoint_IsConfigured())) + return false; + } + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(Number); + return true; +#endif +} + +void Endpoint_ClearEndpoints(void) +{ + UEINT = 0; + + for (uint8_t EPNum = 0; EPNum < ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS; EPNum++) + { + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(EPNum); + UEIENX = 0; + UEINTX = 0; + UECFG1X = 0; + Endpoint_DisableEndpoint(); + } +} + +void Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(void) +{ + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType & REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST) + { + while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + else + { + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } +} + +#if !defined(CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE) +uint8_t Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(void) +{ + #if (USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS < 0xFF) + uint8_t TimeoutMSRem = USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS; + #else + uint16_t TimeoutMSRem = USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS; + #endif + + uint16_t PreviousFrameNumber = USB_Device_GetFrameNumber(); + + for (;;) + { + if (Endpoint_GetEndpointDirection() == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + { + if (Endpoint_IsINReady()) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError; + } + else + { + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError; + } + + uint8_t USB_DeviceState_LCL = USB_DeviceState; + + if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + else if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Suspended) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_BusSuspended; + else if (Endpoint_IsStalled()) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_EndpointStalled; + + uint16_t CurrentFrameNumber = USB_Device_GetFrameNumber(); + + if (CurrentFrameNumber != PreviousFrameNumber) + { + PreviousFrameNumber = CurrentFrameNumber; + + if (!(TimeoutMSRem--)) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_Timeout; + } + } +} +#endif + +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Endpoint_AVR8.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Endpoint_AVR8.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6d8375230e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Endpoint_AVR8.h @@ -0,0 +1,819 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Endpoint definitions for the AVR8 microcontrollers. + * \copydetails Group_EndpointManagement_AVR8 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_EndpointRW + * \defgroup Group_EndpointRW_AVR8 Endpoint Data Reading and Writing (AVR8) + * \brief Endpoint data read/write definitions for the Atmel AVR8 architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing from and to endpoints. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW + * \defgroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_AVR8 Read/Write of Primitive Data Types (AVR8) + * \brief Endpoint primitive read/write definitions for the Atmel AVR8 architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing of primitive data types + * from and to endpoints. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement + * \defgroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_AVR8 Endpoint Packet Management (AVR8) + * \brief Endpoint packet management definitions for the Atmel AVR8 architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to packet management of endpoints. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_EndpointManagement + * \defgroup Group_EndpointManagement_AVR8 Endpoint Management (AVR8) + * \brief Endpoint management definitions for the Atmel AVR8 architecture. + * + * Functions, macros and enums related to endpoint management when in USB Device mode. This + * module contains the endpoint management macros, as well as endpoint interrupt and data + * send/receive functions for various data types. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __ENDPOINT_AVR8_H__ +#define __ENDPOINT_AVR8_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../USBTask.h" + #include "../USBInterrupt.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Inline Functions: */ + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_BytesToEPSizeMask(const uint16_t Bytes) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_CONST + ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_BytesToEPSizeMask(const uint16_t Bytes) + { + uint8_t MaskVal = 0; + uint16_t CheckBytes = 8; + + while (CheckBytes < Bytes) + { + MaskVal++; + CheckBytes <<= 1; + } + + return (MaskVal << EPSIZE0); + } + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void Endpoint_ClearEndpoints(void); + bool Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint_Prv(const uint8_t Number, + const uint8_t UECFG0XData, + const uint8_t UECFG1XData); + + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + #if (!defined(FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + /** Default size of the default control endpoint's bank, until altered by the control endpoint bank size + * value in the device descriptor. Not available if the \c FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE token is defined. + */ + #define ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP_DEFAULT_SIZE 8 + #endif + + #if !defined(CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #if defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Total number of endpoints (including the default control endpoint at address 0) which may + * be used in the device. Different USB AVR models support different amounts of endpoints, + * this value reflects the maximum number of endpoints for the currently selected AVR model. + */ + #define ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS 7 + #else + #define ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS 5 + #endif + #else + #define ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS 1 + #endif + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible error return codes of the \ref Endpoint_WaitUntilReady() function. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointRW_AVR8 + */ + enum Endpoint_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t + { + ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError = 0, /**< Endpoint is ready for next packet, no error. */ + ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_EndpointStalled = 1, /**< The endpoint was stalled during the stream + * transfer by the host or device. + */ + ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected = 2, /**< Device was disconnected from the host while + * waiting for the endpoint to become ready. + */ + ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_BusSuspended = 3, /**< The USB bus has been suspended by the host and + * no USB endpoint traffic can occur until the bus + * has resumed. + */ + ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_Timeout = 4, /**< The host failed to accept or send the next packet + * within the software timeout period set by the + * \ref USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS macro. + */ + }; + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Configures the specified endpoint address with the given endpoint type, bank size and number of hardware + * banks. Once configured, the endpoint may be read from or written to, depending on its direction. + * + * \param[in] Address Endpoint address to configure. + * + * \param[in] Type Type of endpoint to configure, a \c EP_TYPE_* mask. Not all endpoint types + * are available on Low Speed USB devices - refer to the USB 2.0 specification. + * + * \param[in] Size Size of the endpoint's bank, where packets are stored before they are transmitted + * to the USB host, or after they have been received from the USB host (depending on + * the endpoint's data direction). The bank size must indicate the maximum packet size + * that the endpoint can handle. + * + * \param[in] Banks Number of banks to use for the endpoint being configured. + * + * \attention When the \c ORDERED_EP_CONFIG compile time option is used, Endpoints <b>must</b> be configured in + * ascending order, or bank corruption will occur. + * + * \note Different endpoints may have different maximum packet sizes based on the endpoint's index - please + * refer to the chosen microcontroller model's datasheet to determine the maximum bank size for each endpoint. + * \n\n + * + * \note The default control endpoint should not be manually configured by the user application, as + * it is automatically configured by the library internally. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine will automatically select the specified endpoint upon success. Upon failure, the endpoint + * which failed to reconfigure correctly will be selected. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the configuration succeeded, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(const uint8_t Address, + const uint8_t Type, + const uint16_t Size, + const uint8_t Banks) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(const uint8_t Address, + const uint8_t Type, + const uint16_t Size, + const uint8_t Banks) + { + uint8_t Number = (Address & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK); + + if (Number >= ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS) + return false; + + return Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint_Prv(Number, + ((Type << EPTYPE0) | ((Address & ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) ? (1 << EPDIR) : 0)), + ((1 << ALLOC) | ((Banks > 1) ? (1 << EPBK0) : 0) | Endpoint_BytesToEPSizeMask(Size))); + } + + /** Indicates the number of bytes currently stored in the current endpoint's selected bank. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointRW_AVR8 + * + * \return Total number of bytes in the currently selected Endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint16_t Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint16_t Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint(void) + { + #if (defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR)) + return UEBCX; + #elif defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) + return (((uint16_t)UEBCHX << 8) | UEBCLX); + #elif defined(USB_SERIES_2_AVR) + return UEBCLX; + #endif + } + + /** Determines the currently selected endpoint's direction. + * + * \return The currently selected endpoint's direction, as a \c ENDPOINT_DIR_* mask. + */ + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_GetEndpointDirection(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_GetEndpointDirection(void) + { + return (UECFG0X & (1 << EPDIR)) ? ENDPOINT_DIR_IN : ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT; + } + + /** Get the endpoint address of the currently selected endpoint. This is typically used to save + * the currently selected endpoint so that it can be restored after another endpoint has been + * manipulated. + * + * \return Index of the currently selected endpoint. + */ + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_GetCurrentEndpoint(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_GetCurrentEndpoint(void) + { + #if !defined(CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE) + return ((UENUM & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK) | Endpoint_GetEndpointDirection()); + #else + return ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP; + #endif + } + + /** Selects the given endpoint address. + * + * Any endpoint operations which do not require the endpoint address to be indicated will operate on + * the currently selected endpoint. + * + * \param[in] Address Endpoint address to select. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(const uint8_t Address) + { + #if !defined(CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE) + UENUM = (Address & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK); + #endif + } + + /** Resets the endpoint bank FIFO. This clears all the endpoint banks and resets the USB controller's + * data In and Out pointers to the bank's contents. + * + * \param[in] Address Endpoint address whose FIFO buffers are to be reset. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_ResetEndpoint(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_ResetEndpoint(const uint8_t Address) + { + UERST = (1 << (Address & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK)); + UERST = 0; + } + + /** Enables the currently selected endpoint so that data can be sent and received through it to + * and from a host. + * + * \note Endpoints must first be configured properly via \ref Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(). + */ + static inline void Endpoint_EnableEndpoint(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_EnableEndpoint(void) + { + UECONX |= (1 << EPEN); + } + + /** Disables the currently selected endpoint so that data cannot be sent and received through it + * to and from a host. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_DisableEndpoint(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_DisableEndpoint(void) + { + UECONX &= ~(1 << EPEN); + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected endpoint is enabled, but not necessarily configured. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the currently selected endpoint is enabled, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_IsEnabled(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_IsEnabled(void) + { + return ((UECONX & (1 << EPEN)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Retrieves the number of busy banks in the currently selected endpoint, which have been queued for + * transmission via the \ref Endpoint_ClearIN() command, or are awaiting acknowledgment via the + * \ref Endpoint_ClearOUT() command. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_AVR8 + * + * \return Total number of busy banks in the selected endpoint. + */ + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_GetBusyBanks(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_GetBusyBanks(void) + { + return (UESTA0X & (0x03 << NBUSYBK0)); + } + + /** Aborts all pending IN transactions on the currently selected endpoint, once the bank + * has been queued for transmission to the host via \ref Endpoint_ClearIN(). This function + * will terminate all queued transactions, resetting the endpoint banks ready for a new + * packet. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_AVR8 + */ + static inline void Endpoint_AbortPendingIN(void) + { + while (Endpoint_GetBusyBanks() != 0) + { + UEINTX |= (1 << RXOUTI); + while (UEINTX & (1 << RXOUTI)); + } + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected endpoint may be read from (if data is waiting in the endpoint + * bank and the endpoint is an OUT direction, or if the bank is not yet full if the endpoint is an IN + * direction). This function will return false if an error has occurred in the endpoint, if the endpoint + * is an OUT direction and no packet (or an empty packet) has been received, or if the endpoint is an IN + * direction and the endpoint bank is full. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_AVR8 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the currently selected endpoint may be read from or written to, depending + * on its direction. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed(void) + { + return ((UEINTX & (1 << RWAL)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected endpoint is configured. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the currently selected endpoint has been configured, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_IsConfigured(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_IsConfigured(void) + { + return ((UESTA0X & (1 << CFGOK)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Returns a mask indicating which INTERRUPT type endpoints have interrupted - i.e. their + * interrupt duration has elapsed. Which endpoints have interrupted can be determined by + * masking the return value against <tt>(1 << <i>{Endpoint Number}</i>)</tt>. + * + * \return Mask whose bits indicate which endpoints have interrupted. + */ + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_GetEndpointInterrupts(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_GetEndpointInterrupts(void) + { + return UEINT; + } + + /** Determines if the specified endpoint number has interrupted (valid only for INTERRUPT type + * endpoints). + * + * \param[in] Address Address of the endpoint whose interrupt flag should be tested. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the specified endpoint has interrupted, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_HasEndpointInterrupted(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_HasEndpointInterrupted(const uint8_t Address) + { + return ((Endpoint_GetEndpointInterrupts() & (1 << (Address & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK))) ? true : false); + } + + /** Determines if the selected IN endpoint is ready for a new packet to be sent to the host. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_AVR8 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the current endpoint is ready for an IN packet, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_IsINReady(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_IsINReady(void) + { + return ((UEINTX & (1 << TXINI)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Determines if the selected OUT endpoint has received new packet from the host. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_AVR8 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if current endpoint is has received an OUT packet, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_IsOUTReceived(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_IsOUTReceived(void) + { + return ((UEINTX & (1 << RXOUTI)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Determines if the current CONTROL type endpoint has received a SETUP packet. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_AVR8 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the selected endpoint has received a SETUP packet, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived(void) + { + return ((UEINTX & (1 << RXSTPI)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Clears a received SETUP packet on the currently selected CONTROL type endpoint, freeing up the + * endpoint for the next packet. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_AVR8 + * + * \note This is not applicable for non CONTROL type endpoints. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_ClearSETUP(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_ClearSETUP(void) + { + UEINTX &= ~(1 << RXSTPI); + } + + /** Sends an IN packet to the host on the currently selected endpoint, freeing up the endpoint for the + * next packet and switching to the alternative endpoint bank if double banked. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_AVR8 + */ + static inline void Endpoint_ClearIN(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_ClearIN(void) + { + #if !defined(CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE) + UEINTX &= ~((1 << TXINI) | (1 << FIFOCON)); + #else + UEINTX &= ~(1 << TXINI); + #endif + } + + /** Acknowledges an OUT packet to the host on the currently selected endpoint, freeing up the endpoint + * for the next packet and switching to the alternative endpoint bank if double banked. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_AVR8 + */ + static inline void Endpoint_ClearOUT(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_ClearOUT(void) + { + #if !defined(CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE) + UEINTX &= ~((1 << RXOUTI) | (1 << FIFOCON)); + #else + UEINTX &= ~(1 << RXOUTI); + #endif + } + + /** Stalls the current endpoint, indicating to the host that a logical problem occurred with the + * indicated endpoint and that the current transfer sequence should be aborted. This provides a + * way for devices to indicate invalid commands to the host so that the current transfer can be + * aborted and the host can begin its own recovery sequence. + * + * The currently selected endpoint remains stalled until either the \ref Endpoint_ClearStall() macro + * is called, or the host issues a CLEAR FEATURE request to the device for the currently selected + * endpoint. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_AVR8 + */ + static inline void Endpoint_StallTransaction(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_StallTransaction(void) + { + UECONX |= (1 << STALLRQ); + } + + /** Clears the STALL condition on the currently selected endpoint. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_AVR8 + */ + static inline void Endpoint_ClearStall(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_ClearStall(void) + { + UECONX |= (1 << STALLRQC); + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected endpoint is stalled, \c false otherwise. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_AVR8 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the currently selected endpoint is stalled, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_IsStalled(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_IsStalled(void) + { + return ((UECONX & (1 << STALLRQ)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Resets the data toggle of the currently selected endpoint. */ + static inline void Endpoint_ResetDataToggle(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_ResetDataToggle(void) + { + UECONX |= (1 << RSTDT); + } + + /** Sets the direction of the currently selected endpoint. + * + * \param[in] DirectionMask New endpoint direction, as a \c ENDPOINT_DIR_* mask. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(const uint8_t DirectionMask) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(const uint8_t DirectionMask) + { + UECFG0X = ((UECFG0X & ~(1 << EPDIR)) | (DirectionMask ? (1 << EPDIR) : 0)); + } + + /** Reads one byte from the currently selected endpoint's bank, for OUT direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \return Next byte in the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_Read_8(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_Read_8(void) + { + return UEDATX; + } + + /** Writes one byte to the currently selected endpoint's bank, for IN direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write into the the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Write_8(const uint8_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Write_8(const uint8_t Data) + { + UEDATX = Data; + } + + /** Discards one byte from the currently selected endpoint's bank, for OUT direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_AVR8 + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Discard_8(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Discard_8(void) + { + uint8_t Dummy; + + Dummy = UEDATX; + + (void)Dummy; + } + + /** Reads two bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank in little endian format, for OUT + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \return Next two bytes in the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint16_t Endpoint_Read_16_LE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint16_t Endpoint_Read_16_LE(void) + { + union + { + uint16_t Value; + uint8_t Bytes[2]; + } Data; + + Data.Bytes[0] = UEDATX; + Data.Bytes[1] = UEDATX; + + return Data.Value; + } + + /** Reads two bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank in big endian format, for OUT + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \return Next two bytes in the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint16_t Endpoint_Read_16_BE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint16_t Endpoint_Read_16_BE(void) + { + union + { + uint16_t Value; + uint8_t Bytes[2]; + } Data; + + Data.Bytes[1] = UEDATX; + Data.Bytes[0] = UEDATX; + + return Data.Value; + } + + /** Writes two bytes to the currently selected endpoint's bank in little endian format, for IN + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Write_16_LE(const uint16_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Write_16_LE(const uint16_t Data) + { + UEDATX = (Data & 0xFF); + UEDATX = (Data >> 8); + } + + /** Writes two bytes to the currently selected endpoint's bank in big endian format, for IN + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Write_16_BE(const uint16_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Write_16_BE(const uint16_t Data) + { + UEDATX = (Data >> 8); + UEDATX = (Data & 0xFF); + } + + /** Discards two bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank, for OUT direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_AVR8 + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Discard_16(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Discard_16(void) + { + uint8_t Dummy; + + Dummy = UEDATX; + Dummy = UEDATX; + + (void)Dummy; + } + + /** Reads four bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank in little endian format, for OUT + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \return Next four bytes in the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint32_t Endpoint_Read_32_LE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint32_t Endpoint_Read_32_LE(void) + { + union + { + uint32_t Value; + uint8_t Bytes[4]; + } Data; + + Data.Bytes[0] = UEDATX; + Data.Bytes[1] = UEDATX; + Data.Bytes[2] = UEDATX; + Data.Bytes[3] = UEDATX; + + return Data.Value; + } + + /** Reads four bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank in big endian format, for OUT + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \return Next four bytes in the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint32_t Endpoint_Read_32_BE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint32_t Endpoint_Read_32_BE(void) + { + union + { + uint32_t Value; + uint8_t Bytes[4]; + } Data; + + Data.Bytes[3] = UEDATX; + Data.Bytes[2] = UEDATX; + Data.Bytes[1] = UEDATX; + Data.Bytes[0] = UEDATX; + + return Data.Value; + } + + /** Writes four bytes to the currently selected endpoint's bank in little endian format, for IN + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Write_32_LE(const uint32_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Write_32_LE(const uint32_t Data) + { + UEDATX = (Data & 0xFF); + UEDATX = (Data >> 8); + UEDATX = (Data >> 16); + UEDATX = (Data >> 24); + } + + /** Writes four bytes to the currently selected endpoint's bank in big endian format, for IN + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Write_32_BE(const uint32_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Write_32_BE(const uint32_t Data) + { + UEDATX = (Data >> 24); + UEDATX = (Data >> 16); + UEDATX = (Data >> 8); + UEDATX = (Data & 0xFF); + } + + /** Discards four bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank, for OUT direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_AVR8 + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Discard_32(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Discard_32(void) + { + uint8_t Dummy; + + Dummy = UEDATX; + Dummy = UEDATX; + Dummy = UEDATX; + Dummy = UEDATX; + + (void)Dummy; + } + + /* External Variables: */ + /** Global indicating the maximum packet size of the default control endpoint located at address + * 0 in the device. This value is set to the value indicated in the device descriptor in the user + * project once the USB interface is initialized into device mode. + * + * If space is an issue, it is possible to fix this to a static value by defining the control + * endpoint size in the \c FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE token passed to the compiler in the makefile + * via the -D switch. When a fixed control endpoint size is used, the size is no longer dynamically + * read from the descriptors at runtime and instead fixed to the given value. When used, it is + * important that the descriptor control endpoint size value matches the size given as the + * \c FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE token - it is recommended that the \c FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE token + * be used in the device descriptors to ensure this. + * + * \attention This variable should be treated as read-only in the user application, and never manually + * changed in value. + */ + #if (!defined(FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + extern uint8_t USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize; + #else + #define USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE + #endif + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Configures a table of endpoint descriptions, in sequence. This function can be used to configure multiple + * endpoints at the same time. + * + * \note Endpoints with a zero address will be ignored, thus this function cannot be used to configure the + * control endpoint. + * + * \param[in] Table Pointer to a table of endpoint descriptions. + * \param[in] Entries Number of entries in the endpoint table to configure. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if all endpoints configured successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(const USB_Endpoint_Table_t* const Table, + const uint8_t Entries); + + /** Completes the status stage of a control transfer on a CONTROL type endpoint automatically, + * with respect to the data direction. This is a convenience function which can be used to + * simplify user control request handling. + * + * \note This routine should not be called on non CONTROL type endpoints. + */ + void Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(void); + + /** Spin-loops until the currently selected non-control endpoint is ready for the next packet of data + * to be read or written to it. + * + * \note This routine should not be called on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointRW_AVR8 + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(void); + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Host_AVR8.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Host_AVR8.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cbb7735e1c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Host_AVR8.c @@ -0,0 +1,297 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_HOST_C +#include "../Host.h" + +void USB_Host_ProcessNextHostState(void) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode = HOST_ENUMERROR_NoError; + uint8_t SubErrorCode = HOST_ENUMERROR_NoError; + + static uint16_t WaitMSRemaining; + static uint8_t PostWaitState; + + switch (USB_HostState) + { + case HOST_STATE_WaitForDevice: + if (WaitMSRemaining) + { + if ((SubErrorCode = USB_Host_WaitMS(1)) != HOST_WAITERROR_Successful) + { + USB_HostState = PostWaitState; + ErrorCode = HOST_ENUMERROR_WaitStage; + break; + } + + if (!(--WaitMSRemaining)) + USB_HostState = PostWaitState; + } + + break; + case HOST_STATE_Powered: + WaitMSRemaining = HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS; + + USB_HostState = HOST_STATE_Powered_WaitForDeviceSettle; + break; + case HOST_STATE_Powered_WaitForDeviceSettle: + if (WaitMSRemaining--) + { + Delay_MS(1); + break; + } + else + { + USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_Off(); + + USB_OTGPAD_On(); + USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_Enable(); + USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_On(); + + #if defined(NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT) + USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_Enable(); + USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_On(); + #endif + + USB_HostState = HOST_STATE_Powered_WaitForConnect; + } + + break; + case HOST_STATE_Powered_WaitForConnect: + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_DCONNI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_DCONNI); + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_DDISCI); + + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_VBERRI); + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_VBERRI); + + USB_Host_ResumeBus(); + Pipe_ClearPipes(); + + HOST_TASK_NONBLOCK_WAIT(100, HOST_STATE_Powered_DoReset); + } + + break; + case HOST_STATE_Powered_DoReset: + USB_Host_ResetDevice(); + + HOST_TASK_NONBLOCK_WAIT(200, HOST_STATE_Powered_ConfigPipe); + break; + case HOST_STATE_Powered_ConfigPipe: + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE, EP_TYPE_CONTROL, ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP, PIPE_CONTROLPIPE_DEFAULT_SIZE, 1))) + { + ErrorCode = HOST_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigError; + SubErrorCode = 0; + break; + } + + USB_HostState = HOST_STATE_Default; + break; + case HOST_STATE_Default: + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_DEVICE), + .bRequest = REQ_GetDescriptor, + .wValue = (DTYPE_Device << 8), + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = 8, + }; + + uint8_t DataBuffer[8]; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + if ((SubErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(DataBuffer)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + ErrorCode = HOST_ENUMERROR_ControlError; + break; + } + + USB_Host_ControlPipeSize = DataBuffer[offsetof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t, Endpoint0Size)]; + + USB_Host_ResetDevice(); + + HOST_TASK_NONBLOCK_WAIT(200, HOST_STATE_Default_PostReset); + break; + case HOST_STATE_Default_PostReset: + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE, EP_TYPE_CONTROL, ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP, USB_Host_ControlPipeSize, 1))) + { + ErrorCode = HOST_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigError; + SubErrorCode = 0; + break; + } + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_DEVICE), + .bRequest = REQ_SetAddress, + .wValue = USB_HOST_DEVICEADDRESS, + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + if ((SubErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(NULL)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + ErrorCode = HOST_ENUMERROR_ControlError; + break; + } + + HOST_TASK_NONBLOCK_WAIT(100, HOST_STATE_Default_PostAddressSet); + break; + case HOST_STATE_Default_PostAddressSet: + USB_Host_SetDeviceAddress(USB_HOST_DEVICEADDRESS); + + USB_HostState = HOST_STATE_Addressed; + + EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(); + break; + + default: + break; + } + + if ((ErrorCode != HOST_ENUMERROR_NoError) && (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Unattached)) + { + EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(ErrorCode, SubErrorCode); + + USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_Off(); + + EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(); + + USB_ResetInterface(); + } +} + +uint8_t USB_Host_WaitMS(uint8_t MS) +{ + bool BusSuspended = USB_Host_IsBusSuspended(); + uint8_t ErrorCode = HOST_WAITERROR_Successful; + bool HSOFIEnabled = USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_HSOFI); + + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_HSOFI); + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_HSOFI); + + USB_Host_ResumeBus(); + + while (MS) + { + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_HSOFI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_HSOFI); + MS--; + } + + if ((USB_HostState == HOST_STATE_Unattached) || (USB_CurrentMode != USB_MODE_Host)) + { + ErrorCode = HOST_WAITERROR_DeviceDisconnect; + + break; + } + + if (Pipe_IsError()) + { + Pipe_ClearError(); + ErrorCode = HOST_WAITERROR_PipeError; + + break; + } + + if (Pipe_IsStalled()) + { + Pipe_ClearStall(); + ErrorCode = HOST_WAITERROR_SetupStalled; + + break; + } + } + + if (BusSuspended) + USB_Host_SuspendBus(); + + if (HSOFIEnabled) + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_HSOFI); + + return ErrorCode; +} + +static void USB_Host_ResetDevice(void) +{ + bool BusSuspended = USB_Host_IsBusSuspended(); + + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_DDISCI); + + USB_Host_ResetBus(); + while (!(USB_Host_IsBusResetComplete())); + USB_Host_ResumeBus(); + + USB_Host_ConfigurationNumber = 0; + + bool HSOFIEnabled = USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_HSOFI); + + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_HSOFI); + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_HSOFI); + + for (uint8_t MSRem = 10; MSRem != 0; MSRem--) + { + /* Workaround for powerless-pull-up devices. After a USB bus reset, + all disconnection interrupts are suppressed while a USB frame is + looked for - if it is found within 10ms, the device is still + present. */ + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_HSOFI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_HSOFI); + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_DDISCI); + break; + } + + Delay_MS(1); + } + + if (HSOFIEnabled) + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_HSOFI); + + if (BusSuspended) + USB_Host_SuspendBus(); + + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_DDISCI); +} + +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Host_AVR8.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Host_AVR8.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7a48e3162d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Host_AVR8.h @@ -0,0 +1,372 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Host definitions for the AVR8 microcontrollers. + * \copydetails Group_Host_AVR8 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Host + * \defgroup Group_Host_AVR8 Host Management (AVR8) + * \brief USB Host definitions for the AVR8 microcontrollers. + * + * Architecture specific USB Host definitions for the Atmel 8-bit AVR microcontrollers. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __USBHOST_AVR8_H__ +#define __USBHOST_AVR8_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../StdDescriptors.h" + #include "../Pipe.h" + #include "../USBInterrupt.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + #if defined(INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE) && !defined(NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT) + #error The INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE compile option requires NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT for the AVR8 architecture. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the fixed USB device address which any attached device is enumerated to when in + * host mode. As only one USB device may be attached to the AVR in host mode at any one time + * and that the address used is not important (other than the fact that it is non-zero), a + * fixed value is specified by the library. + */ + #define USB_HOST_DEVICEADDRESS 1 + + #if !defined(HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Constant for the delay in milliseconds after a device is connected before the library + * will start the enumeration process. Some devices require a delay of up to 5 seconds + * after connection before the enumeration process can start or incorrect operation will + * occur. + * + * The default delay value may be overridden in the user project makefile by defining the + * \c HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS token to the required delay in milliseconds, and passed to the + * compiler using the -D switch. + */ + #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS 1000 + #endif + + /** Enum for the error codes for the \ref EVENT_USB_Host_HostError() event. + * + * \see \ref Group_Events for more information on this event. + */ + enum USB_Host_ErrorCodes_t + { + HOST_ERROR_VBusVoltageDip = 0, /**< VBUS voltage dipped to an unacceptable level. This + * error may be the result of an attached device drawing + * too much current from the VBUS line, or due to the + * AVR's power source being unable to supply sufficient + * current. + */ + }; + + /** Enum for the error codes for the \ref EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed() event. + * + * \see \ref Group_Events for more information on this event. + */ + enum USB_Host_EnumerationErrorCodes_t + { + HOST_ENUMERROR_NoError = 0, /**< No error occurred. Used internally, this is not a valid + * ErrorCode parameter value for the \ref EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed() + * event. + */ + HOST_ENUMERROR_WaitStage = 1, /**< One of the delays between enumeration steps failed + * to complete successfully, due to a timeout or other + * error. + */ + HOST_ENUMERROR_NoDeviceDetected = 2, /**< No device was detected, despite the USB data lines + * indicating the attachment of a device. + */ + HOST_ENUMERROR_ControlError = 3, /**< One of the enumeration control requests failed to + * complete successfully. + */ + HOST_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigError = 4, /**< The default control pipe (address 0) failed to + * configure correctly. + */ + }; + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Returns the current USB frame number, when in host mode. Every millisecond the USB bus is active (i.e. not suspended) + * the frame number is incremented by one. + * + * \return Current USB frame number from the USB controller. + */ + static inline uint16_t USB_Host_GetFrameNumber(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint16_t USB_Host_GetFrameNumber(void) + { + return UHFNUM; + } + + #if !defined(NO_SOF_EVENTS) + /** Enables the host mode Start Of Frame events. When enabled, this causes the + * \ref EVENT_USB_Host_StartOfFrame() event to fire once per millisecond, synchronized to the USB bus, + * at the start of each USB frame when a device is enumerated while in host mode. + * + * \note This function is not available when the \c NO_SOF_EVENTS compile time token is defined. + */ + static inline void USB_Host_EnableSOFEvents(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_EnableSOFEvents(void) + { + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_HSOFI); + } + + /** Disables the host mode Start Of Frame events. When disabled, this stops the firing of the + * \ref EVENT_USB_Host_StartOfFrame() event when enumerated in host mode. + * + * \note This function is not available when the \c NO_SOF_EVENTS compile time token is defined. + */ + static inline void USB_Host_DisableSOFEvents(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_DisableSOFEvents(void) + { + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_HSOFI); + } + #endif + + /** Resets the USB bus, including the endpoints in any attached device and pipes on the AVR host. + * USB bus resets leave the default control pipe configured (if already configured). + * + * If the USB bus has been suspended prior to issuing a bus reset, the attached device will be + * woken up automatically and the bus resumed after the reset has been correctly issued. + */ + static inline void USB_Host_ResetBus(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_ResetBus(void) + { + UHCON |= (1 << RESET); + } + + /** Determines if a previously issued bus reset (via the \ref USB_Host_ResetBus() macro) has + * completed. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if no bus reset is currently being sent, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool USB_Host_IsBusResetComplete(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool USB_Host_IsBusResetComplete(void) + { + return ((UHCON & (1 << RESET)) ? false : true); + } + + /** Resumes USB communications with an attached and enumerated device, by resuming the transmission + * of the 1MS Start Of Frame messages to the device. When resumed, USB communications between the + * host and attached device may occur. + */ + static inline void USB_Host_ResumeBus(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_ResumeBus(void) + { + UHCON |= (1 << SOFEN); + } + + /** Suspends the USB bus, preventing any communications from occurring between the host and attached + * device until the bus has been resumed. This stops the transmission of the 1MS Start Of Frame + * messages to the device. + * + * \attention While the USB bus is suspended, all USB interrupt sources are also disabled; this means that + * some events (such as device disconnections) will not fire until the bus is resumed. + */ + static inline void USB_Host_SuspendBus(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_SuspendBus(void) + { + UHCON &= ~(1 << SOFEN); + } + + /** Determines if the USB bus has been suspended via the use of the \ref USB_Host_SuspendBus() macro, + * false otherwise. While suspended, no USB communications can occur until the bus is resumed, + * except for the Remote Wakeup event from the device if supported. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the bus is currently suspended, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool USB_Host_IsBusSuspended(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool USB_Host_IsBusSuspended(void) + { + return ((UHCON & (1 << SOFEN)) ? false : true); + } + + /** Determines if the attached device is currently enumerated in Full Speed mode (12Mb/s), or + * false if the attached device is enumerated in Low Speed mode (1.5Mb/s). + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the attached device is enumerated in Full Speed mode, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool USB_Host_IsDeviceFullSpeed(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool USB_Host_IsDeviceFullSpeed(void) + { + return ((USBSTA & (1 << SPEED)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Determines if the attached device is currently issuing a Remote Wakeup request, requesting + * that the host resume the USB bus and wake up the device, \c false otherwise. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the attached device has sent a Remote Wakeup request, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool USB_Host_IsRemoteWakeupSent(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool USB_Host_IsRemoteWakeupSent(void) + { + return ((UHINT & (1 << RXRSMI)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Clears the flag indicating that a Remote Wakeup request has been issued by an attached device. */ + static inline void USB_Host_ClearRemoteWakeupSent(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_ClearRemoteWakeupSent(void) + { + UHINT &= ~(1 << RXRSMI); + } + + /** Accepts a Remote Wakeup request from an attached device. This must be issued in response to + * a device's Remote Wakeup request within 2ms for the request to be accepted and the bus to + * be resumed. + */ + static inline void USB_Host_ResumeFromWakeupRequest(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_ResumeFromWakeupRequest(void) + { + UHCON |= (1 << RESUME); + } + + /** Determines if a resume from Remote Wakeup request is currently being sent to an attached + * device. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if no resume request is currently being sent, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool USB_Host_IsResumeFromWakeupRequestSent(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool USB_Host_IsResumeFromWakeupRequestSent(void) + { + return ((UHCON & (1 << RESUME)) ? false : true); + } + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + static inline void USB_Host_HostMode_On(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_HostMode_On(void) + { + USBCON |= (1 << HOST); + } + + static inline void USB_Host_HostMode_Off(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_HostMode_Off(void) + { + USBCON &= ~(1 << HOST); + } + + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_Enable(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_Enable(void) + { + OTGCON &= ~(1 << VBUSHWC); + UHWCON |= (1 << UVCONE); + } + + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_Enable(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_Enable(void) + { + OTGCON |= (1 << VBUSHWC); + UHWCON &= ~(1 << UVCONE); + + DDRE |= (1 << 7); + } + + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_On(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_On(void) + { + OTGCON |= (1 << VBUSREQ); + } + + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_On(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_On(void) + { + #if defined(INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE) + PORTE &= ~(1 << 7); + #else + PORTE |= (1 << 7); + #endif + } + + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_Off(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_Off(void) + { + OTGCON |= (1 << VBUSRQC); + } + + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_Off(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_Off(void) + { + #if defined(INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE) + PORTE |= (1 << 7); + #else + PORTE &= ~(1 << 7); + #endif + } + + static inline void USB_Host_SetDeviceAddress(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_SetDeviceAddress(const uint8_t Address) + { + UHADDR = (Address & 0x7F); + } + + /* Enums: */ + enum USB_Host_WaitMSErrorCodes_t + { + HOST_WAITERROR_Successful = 0, + HOST_WAITERROR_DeviceDisconnect = 1, + HOST_WAITERROR_PipeError = 2, + HOST_WAITERROR_SetupStalled = 3, + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void USB_Host_ProcessNextHostState(void); + uint8_t USB_Host_WaitMS(uint8_t MS); + + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_HOST_C) + static void USB_Host_ResetDevice(void); + #endif + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/OTG_AVR8.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/OTG_AVR8.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..74c70ccdfd --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/OTG_AVR8.h @@ -0,0 +1,159 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB OTG definitions for the AVR8 microcontrollers. + * \copydetails Group_OTG_AVR8 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_OTG + * \defgroup Group_OTG_AVR8 USB On The Go (OTG) Management (AVR8) + * \brief USB OTG definitions for the AVR8 microcontrollers. + * + * Architecture specific USB OTG definitions for the Atmel 8-bit AVR microcontrollers. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __USBOTG_AVR8_H__ +#define __USBOTG_AVR8_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Mask for the VBUS pulsing method of SRP, supported by some OTG devices. + * + * \see \ref USB_OTG_Device_InitiateSRP(). + */ + #define USB_OTG_SRP_VBUS (1 << SRPSEL) + + /** Mask for the Data + pulsing method of SRP, supported by some OTG devices. + * + * \see \ref USB_OTG_Device_InitiateSRP(). + */ + #define USB_OTG_STP_DATA 0 + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initiate a Host Negotiation Protocol request. This indicates to the other connected device + * that the device wishes to change device/host roles. + */ + static inline void USB_OTG_Device_RequestHNP(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_OTG_Device_RequestHNP(void) + { + OTGCON |= (1 << HNPREQ); + } + + /** Cancel a Host Negotiation Protocol request. This stops a pending HNP request to the other + * connected device. + */ + static inline void USB_OTG_Device_CancelHNPRequest(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_OTG_Device_CancelHNPRequest(void) + { + OTGCON &= ~(1 << HNPREQ); + } + + /** Determines if the device is currently sending a HNP to an attached host. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if currently sending a HNP to the other connected device, \c false otherwise + */ + static inline bool USB_OTG_Device_IsSendingHNP(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool USB_OTG_Device_IsSendingHNP(void) + { + return ((OTGCON & (1 << HNPREQ)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Initiates a Session Request Protocol request. Most OTG devices turn off VBUS when the USB + * interface is not in use, to conserve power. Sending a SRP to a USB OTG device running in + * host mode indicates that VBUS should be applied and a session started. + * + * There are two different methods of sending a SRP - either pulses on the VBUS line, or by + * pulsing the Data + line via the internal pull-up resistor. + * + * \param[in] SRPTypeMask Mask indicating the type of SRP to use, either \ref USB_OTG_SRP_VBUS or + * \ref USB_OTG_STP_DATA. + */ + static inline void USB_OTG_Device_InitiateSRP(const uint8_t SRPTypeMask) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_OTG_Device_InitiateSRP(const uint8_t SRPTypeMask) + { + OTGCON = ((OTGCON & ~(1 << SRPSEL)) | (SRPTypeMask | (1 << SRPREQ))); + } + + /** Accepts a HNP from a connected device, indicating that both devices should exchange + * device/host roles. + */ + static inline void USB_OTG_Host_AcceptHNP(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_OTG_Host_AcceptHNP(void) + { + OTGCON |= (1 << HNPREQ); + } + + /** Rejects a HNP from a connected device, indicating that both devices should remain in their + * current device/host roles. + */ + static inline void USB_OTG_Host_RejectHNP(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_OTG_Host_RejectHNP(void) + { + OTGCON &= ~(1 << HNPREQ); + } + + /** Indicates if the connected device is currently sending a HNP request. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if a HNP is currently being issued by the connected device, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool USB_OTG_Host_IsHNPReceived(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool USB_OTG_Host_IsHNPReceived(void) + { + return ((OTGCON & (1 << HNPREQ)) ? true : false); + } + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/PipeStream_AVR8.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/PipeStream_AVR8.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7b17d45d4f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/PipeStream_AVR8.c @@ -0,0 +1,221 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + +#include "PipeStream_AVR8.h" + +uint8_t Pipe_Discard_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + uint16_t BytesInTransfer = 0; + + Pipe_SetPipeToken(PIPE_TOKEN_IN); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + Length -= *BytesProcessed; + + while (Length) + { + if (!(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Pipe_ClearIN(); + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + *BytesProcessed += BytesInTransfer; + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + } + else + { + Pipe_Discard_8(); + + Length--; + BytesInTransfer++; + } + } + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +uint8_t Pipe_Null_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + uint16_t BytesInTransfer = 0; + + Pipe_SetPipeToken(PIPE_TOKEN_OUT); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + Length -= *BytesProcessed; + + while (Length) + { + if (!(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + *BytesProcessed += BytesInTransfer; + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer; + } + + USB_USBTask(); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + } + else + { + Pipe_Write_8(0); + + Length--; + BytesInTransfer++; + } + } + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +/* The following abuses the C preprocessor in order to copy-paste common code with slight alterations, + * so that the code needs to be written once. It is a crude form of templating to reduce code maintenance. */ + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Pipe_Write_Stream_LE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* +#define TEMPLATE_TOKEN PIPE_TOKEN_OUT +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_PIPE() Pipe_ClearOUT() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) DataStream += Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Pipe_Write_8(*BufferPtr) +#include "Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Pipe_Write_Stream_BE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* +#define TEMPLATE_TOKEN PIPE_TOKEN_OUT +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_PIPE() Pipe_ClearOUT() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) DataStream -= Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Pipe_Write_8(*BufferPtr) +#include "Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Pipe_Read_Stream_LE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE void* +#define TEMPLATE_TOKEN PIPE_TOKEN_IN +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_PIPE() Pipe_ClearIN() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) DataStream += Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) *BufferPtr = Pipe_Read_8() +#include "Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Pipe_Read_Stream_BE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE void* +#define TEMPLATE_TOKEN PIPE_TOKEN_IN +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_PIPE() Pipe_ClearIN() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) DataStream -= Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) *BufferPtr = Pipe_Read_8() +#include "Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Pipe_Write_PStream_LE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* +#define TEMPLATE_TOKEN PIPE_TOKEN_OUT +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_PIPE() Pipe_ClearOUT() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) DataStream += Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Pipe_Write_8(pgm_read_byte(BufferPtr)) +#include "Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Pipe_Write_PStream_BE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* +#define TEMPLATE_TOKEN PIPE_TOKEN_OUT +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_PIPE() Pipe_ClearOUT() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) DataStream -= Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Pipe_Write_8(pgm_read_byte(BufferPtr)) +#include "Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Pipe_Write_EStream_LE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* +#define TEMPLATE_TOKEN PIPE_TOKEN_OUT +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_PIPE() Pipe_ClearOUT() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) DataStream += Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Pipe_Write_8(eeprom_read_byte(BufferPtr)) +#include "Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Pipe_Write_EStream_BE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* +#define TEMPLATE_TOKEN PIPE_TOKEN_OUT +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_PIPE() Pipe_ClearOUT() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) DataStream -= Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Pipe_Write_8(eeprom_read_byte(BufferPtr)) +#include "Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Pipe_Read_EStream_LE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE void* +#define TEMPLATE_TOKEN PIPE_TOKEN_IN +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_PIPE() Pipe_ClearIN() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) DataStream += Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) eeprom_update_byte(BufferPtr, Pipe_Read_8()) +#include "Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Pipe_Read_EStream_BE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE void* +#define TEMPLATE_TOKEN PIPE_TOKEN_IN +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_PIPE() Pipe_ClearIN() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) DataStream -= Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) eeprom_update_byte(BufferPtr, Pipe_Read_8()) +#include "Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c" + +#endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/PipeStream_AVR8.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/PipeStream_AVR8.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ca63bdf5a2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/PipeStream_AVR8.h @@ -0,0 +1,442 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Pipe data stream transmission and reception management for the AVR8 microcontrollers + * \copydetails Group_PipeStreamRW_AVR8 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PipeStreamRW + * \defgroup Group_PipeStreamRW_AVR8 Read/Write of Multi-Byte Streams (AVR8) + * \brief Pipe data stream transmission and reception management for the Atmel AVR8 architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing of data streams from + * and to pipes. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __PIPE_STREAM_AVR8_H__ +#define __PIPE_STREAM_AVR8_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../USBMode.h" + #include "../USBTask.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** \name Stream functions for null data */ + //@{ + + /** Reads and discards the given number of bytes from the pipe, discarding fully read packets from the host + * as needed. The last packet is not automatically discarded once the remaining bytes has been read; the + * user is responsible for manually discarding the last packet from the device via the \ref Pipe_ClearIN() macro. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, failing or + * succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid storage location, the transfer + * will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time the pipe bank becomes empty while there is still data + * to process (and after the current packet has been acknowledged) the BytesProcessed location will be updated with + * the total number of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed in the user code - to + * continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters and it will resume until the BytesProcessed + * value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Discard_Stream(512, NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Discard_Stream(512, &BytesProcessed)) == PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note The pipe token is set automatically, thus this can be used on bi-directional pipes directly without + * having to explicitly change the data direction with a call to \ref Pipe_SetPipeToken(). + * + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to discard via the currently selected pipe. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes already processed should + * updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be processed at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_Discard_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed); + + /** Writes a given number of zeroed bytes to the pipe, sending full pipe packets from the host to the device + * as needed. The last packet is not automatically sent once the remaining bytes has been written; the + * user is responsible for manually discarding the last packet from the device via the \ref Pipe_ClearOUT() macro. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, failing or + * succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid storage location, the transfer + * will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time the pipe bank becomes full while there is still data + * to process (and after the current packet transmission has been initiated) the BytesProcessed location will be + * updated with the total number of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed in the user code - to + * continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters and it will resume until the BytesProcessed + * value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Null_Stream(512, NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Null_Stream(512, &BytesProcessed)) == PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note The pipe token is set automatically, thus this can be used on bi-directional pipes directly without + * having to explicitly change the data direction with a call to \ref Pipe_SetPipeToken(). + * + * \param[in] Length Number of zero bytes to write via the currently selected pipe. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes already processed should + * updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be processed at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_Null_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed); + + //@} + + /** \name Stream functions for RAM source/destination data */ + //@{ + + /** Writes the given number of bytes to the pipe from the given buffer in little endian, + * sending full packets to the device as needed. The last packet filled is not automatically sent; + * the user is responsible for manually sending the last written packet to the host via the + * \ref Pipe_ClearOUT() macro. Between each USB packet, the given stream callback function is + * executed repeatedly until the next packet is ready, allowing for early aborts of stream transfers. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, + * failing or succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid + * storage location, the transfer will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time + * the pipe bank becomes full while there is still data to process (and after the current + * packet transmission has been initiated) the BytesProcessed location will be updated with the + * total number of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed + * in the user code - to continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters + * and it will resume until the BytesProcessed value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * &BytesProcessed)) == PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note The pipe token is set automatically, thus this can be used on bi-directional pipes directly without + * having to explicitly change the data direction with a call to \ref Pipe_SetPipeToken(). + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected pipe into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes already processed should + * updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Writes the given number of bytes to the pipe from the given buffer in big endian, + * sending full packets to the device as needed. The last packet filled is not automatically sent; + * the user is responsible for manually sending the last written packet to the host via the + * \ref Pipe_ClearOUT() macro. Between each USB packet, the given stream callback function is + * executed repeatedly until the next packet is ready, allowing for early aborts of stream transfers. + * + * \note The pipe token is set automatically, thus this can be used on bi-directional pipes directly without + * having to explicitly change the data direction with a call to \ref Pipe_SetPipeToken(). + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected pipe into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes already processed should + * updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_Write_Stream_BE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads the given number of bytes from the pipe into the given buffer in little endian, + * sending full packets to the device as needed. The last packet filled is not automatically sent; + * the user is responsible for manually sending the last written packet to the host via the + * \ref Pipe_ClearIN() macro. Between each USB packet, the given stream callback function is + * executed repeatedly until the next packet is ready, allowing for early aborts of stream transfers. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, + * failing or succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid + * storage location, the transfer will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time + * the pipe bank becomes empty while there is still data to process (and after the current + * packet has been acknowledged) the BytesProcessed location will be updated with the total number + * of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed + * in the user code - to continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters + * and it will resume until the BytesProcessed value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * &BytesProcessed)) == PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note The pipe token is set automatically, thus this can be used on bi-directional pipes directly without + * having to explicitly change the data direction with a call to \ref Pipe_SetPipeToken(). + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected pipe to read from. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes already processed should + * updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads the given number of bytes from the pipe into the given buffer in big endian, + * sending full packets to the device as needed. The last packet filled is not automatically sent; + * the user is responsible for manually sending the last written packet to the host via the + * \ref Pipe_ClearIN() macro. Between each USB packet, the given stream callback function is + * executed repeatedly until the next packet is ready, allowing for early aborts of stream transfers. + * + * \note The pipe token is set automatically, thus this can be used on bi-directional pipes directly without + * having to explicitly change the data direction with a call to \ref Pipe_SetPipeToken(). + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected pipe to read from. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes already processed should + * updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_Read_Stream_BE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + //@} + + /** \name Stream functions for EEPROM source/destination data */ + //@{ + + /** EEPROM buffer source version of \ref Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(). + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected pipe into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes already processed should + * updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_Write_EStream_LE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** EEPROM buffer source version of \ref Pipe_Write_Stream_BE(). + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected pipe into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes already processed should + * updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_Write_EStream_BE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** EEPROM buffer source version of \ref Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(). + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected pipe to read from. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes already processed should + * updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_Read_EStream_LE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** EEPROM buffer source version of \ref Pipe_Read_Stream_BE(). + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected pipe to read from. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes already processed should + * updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_Read_EStream_BE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + //@} + + /** \name Stream functions for PROGMEM source/destination data */ + //@{ + + /** FLASH buffer source version of \ref Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(). + * + * \pre The FLASH data must be located in the first 64KB of FLASH for this function to work correctly. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected pipe into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes already processed should + * updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_Write_PStream_LE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** FLASH buffer source version of \ref Pipe_Write_Stream_BE(). + * + * \pre The FLASH data must be located in the first 64KB of FLASH for this function to work correctly. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected pipe into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes already processed should + * updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_Write_PStream_BE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + //@} + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Pipe_AVR8.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Pipe_AVR8.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..20239d06f8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Pipe_AVR8.c @@ -0,0 +1,210 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + +#include "../Pipe.h" + +uint8_t USB_Host_ControlPipeSize = PIPE_CONTROLPIPE_DEFAULT_SIZE; + +bool Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(const USB_Pipe_Table_t* const Table, + const uint8_t Entries) +{ + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < Entries; i++) + { + if (!(Table[i].Address)) + continue; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipe(Table[i].Address, Table[i].Type, Table[i].EndpointAddress, Table[i].Size, Table[i].Banks))) + { + return false; + } + } + + return true; +} + +bool Pipe_ConfigurePipe(const uint8_t Address, + const uint8_t Type, + const uint8_t EndpointAddress, + const uint16_t Size, + const uint8_t Banks) +{ + uint8_t Number = (Address & PIPE_EPNUM_MASK); + uint8_t Token = (Address & PIPE_DIR_IN) ? PIPE_TOKEN_IN : PIPE_TOKEN_OUT; + + if (Number >= PIPE_TOTAL_PIPES) + return false; + + if (Type == EP_TYPE_CONTROL) + Token = PIPE_TOKEN_SETUP; + +#if defined(ORDERED_EP_CONFIG) + Pipe_SelectPipe(Number); + Pipe_EnablePipe(); + + UPCFG1X = 0; + + UPCFG0X = ((Type << EPTYPE0) | Token | ((EndpointAddress & PIPE_EPNUM_MASK) << PEPNUM0)); + UPCFG1X = ((1 << ALLOC) | ((Banks > 1) ? (1 << EPBK0) : 0) | Pipe_BytesToEPSizeMask(Size)); + + Pipe_SetInfiniteINRequests(); + + return Pipe_IsConfigured(); +#else + for (uint8_t PNum = Number; PNum < PIPE_TOTAL_PIPES; PNum++) + { + uint8_t UPCFG0XTemp; + uint8_t UPCFG1XTemp; + uint8_t UPCFG2XTemp; + uint8_t UPIENXTemp; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PNum); + + if (PNum == Number) + { + UPCFG0XTemp = ((Type << EPTYPE0) | Token | ((EndpointAddress & PIPE_EPNUM_MASK) << PEPNUM0)); + UPCFG1XTemp = ((1 << ALLOC) | ((Banks > 1) ? (1 << EPBK0) : 0) | Pipe_BytesToEPSizeMask(Size)); + UPCFG2XTemp = 0; + UPIENXTemp = 0; + } + else + { + UPCFG0XTemp = UPCFG0X; + UPCFG1XTemp = UPCFG1X; + UPCFG2XTemp = UPCFG2X; + UPIENXTemp = UPIENX; + } + + if (!(UPCFG1XTemp & (1 << ALLOC))) + continue; + + Pipe_DisablePipe(); + UPCFG1X &= ~(1 << ALLOC); + + Pipe_EnablePipe(); + UPCFG0X = UPCFG0XTemp; + UPCFG1X = UPCFG1XTemp; + UPCFG2X = UPCFG2XTemp; + UPIENX = UPIENXTemp; + + Pipe_SetInfiniteINRequests(); + + if (!(Pipe_IsConfigured())) + return false; + } + + Pipe_SelectPipe(Number); + return true; +#endif +} + +void Pipe_ClearPipes(void) +{ + UPINT = 0; + + for (uint8_t PNum = 0; PNum < PIPE_TOTAL_PIPES; PNum++) + { + Pipe_SelectPipe(PNum); + UPIENX = 0; + UPINTX = 0; + UPCFG1X = 0; + Pipe_DisablePipe(); + } +} + +bool Pipe_IsEndpointBound(const uint8_t EndpointAddress) +{ + uint8_t PrevPipeNumber = Pipe_GetCurrentPipe(); + + for (uint8_t PNum = 0; PNum < PIPE_TOTAL_PIPES; PNum++) + { + Pipe_SelectPipe(PNum); + + if (!(Pipe_IsConfigured())) + continue; + + if (Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress() == EndpointAddress) + return true; + } + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PrevPipeNumber); + return false; +} + +uint8_t Pipe_WaitUntilReady(void) +{ + #if (USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS < 0xFF) + uint8_t TimeoutMSRem = USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS; + #else + uint16_t TimeoutMSRem = USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS; + #endif + + uint16_t PreviousFrameNumber = USB_Host_GetFrameNumber(); + + for (;;) + { + if (Pipe_GetPipeToken() == PIPE_TOKEN_IN) + { + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError; + } + else + { + if (Pipe_IsOUTReady()) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError; + } + + if (Pipe_IsStalled()) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_PipeStalled; + else if (USB_HostState == HOST_STATE_Unattached) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint16_t CurrentFrameNumber = USB_Host_GetFrameNumber(); + + if (CurrentFrameNumber != PreviousFrameNumber) + { + PreviousFrameNumber = CurrentFrameNumber; + + if (!(TimeoutMSRem--)) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_Timeout; + } + } +} + +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Pipe_AVR8.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Pipe_AVR8.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3521efbe9e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Pipe_AVR8.h @@ -0,0 +1,922 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Pipe definitions for the AVR8 microcontrollers. + * \copydetails Group_PipeManagement_AVR8 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PipeRW + * \defgroup Group_PipeRW_AVR8 Pipe Data Reading and Writing (AVR8) + * \brief Pipe data read/write definitions for the Atmel AVR8 architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing from and to pipes. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW + * \defgroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_AVR8 Read/Write of Primitive Data Types (AVR8) + * \brief Pipe primitive data read/write definitions for the Atmel AVR8 architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing of primitive data types + * from and to pipes. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement + * \defgroup Group_PipePacketManagement_AVR8 Pipe Packet Management (AVR8) + * \brief Pipe packet management definitions for the Atmel AVR8 architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to packet management of pipes. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PipeControlReq + * \defgroup Group_PipeControlReq_AVR8 Pipe Control Request Management (AVR8) + * \brief Pipe control request management definitions for the Atmel AVR8 architecture. + * + * Module for host mode request processing. This module allows for the transmission of standard, class and + * vendor control requests to the default control endpoint of an attached device while in host mode. + * + * \see Chapter 9 of the USB 2.0 specification. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PipeManagement + * \defgroup Group_PipeManagement_AVR8 Pipe Management (AVR8) + * \brief Pipe management definitions for the Atmel AVR8 architecture. + * + * This module contains functions, macros and enums related to pipe management when in USB Host mode. This + * module contains the pipe management macros, as well as pipe interrupt and data send/receive functions + * for various data types. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __PIPE_AVR8_H__ +#define __PIPE_AVR8_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../USBTask.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** \name Pipe Error Flag Masks */ + //@{ + /** Mask for \ref Pipe_GetErrorFlags(), indicating that an overflow error occurred in the pipe on the received data. */ + #define PIPE_ERRORFLAG_OVERFLOW (1 << 6) + + /** Mask for \ref Pipe_GetErrorFlags(), indicating that an underflow error occurred in the pipe on the received data. */ + #define PIPE_ERRORFLAG_UNDERFLOW (1 << 5) + + /** Mask for \ref Pipe_GetErrorFlags(), indicating that a CRC error occurred in the pipe on the received data. */ + #define PIPE_ERRORFLAG_CRC16 (1 << 4) + + /** Mask for \ref Pipe_GetErrorFlags(), indicating that a hardware timeout error occurred in the pipe. */ + #define PIPE_ERRORFLAG_TIMEOUT (1 << 3) + + /** Mask for \ref Pipe_GetErrorFlags(), indicating that a hardware PID error occurred in the pipe. */ + #define PIPE_ERRORFLAG_PID (1 << 2) + + /** Mask for \ref Pipe_GetErrorFlags(), indicating that a hardware data PID error occurred in the pipe. */ + #define PIPE_ERRORFLAG_DATAPID (1 << 1) + + /** Mask for \ref Pipe_GetErrorFlags(), indicating that a hardware data toggle error occurred in the pipe. */ + #define PIPE_ERRORFLAG_DATATGL (1 << 0) + //@} + + /** \name Pipe Token Masks */ + //@{ + /** Token mask for \ref Pipe_SetPipeToken() and \ref Pipe_GetPipeToken(). This sets the pipe as a SETUP token (for CONTROL type pipes), + * which will trigger a control request on the attached device when data is written to the pipe. + */ + #define PIPE_TOKEN_SETUP (0 << PTOKEN0) + + /** Token mask for \ref Pipe_SetPipeToken() and \ref Pipe_GetPipeToken(). This sets the pipe as a IN token (for non-CONTROL type pipes), + * indicating that the pipe data will flow from device to host. + */ + #define PIPE_TOKEN_IN (1 << PTOKEN0) + + /** Token mask for \ref Pipe_SetPipeToken() and \ref Pipe_GetPipeToken(). This sets the pipe as a OUT token (for non-CONTROL type pipes), + * indicating that the pipe data will flow from host to device. + */ + #define PIPE_TOKEN_OUT (2 << PTOKEN0) + //@} + + /** Default size of the default control pipe's bank, until altered by the Endpoint0Size value + * in the device descriptor of the attached device. + */ + #define PIPE_CONTROLPIPE_DEFAULT_SIZE 64 + + /** Total number of pipes (including the default control pipe at address 0) which may be used in + * the device. Different USB AVR models support different amounts of pipes, this value reflects + * the maximum number of pipes for the currently selected AVR model. + */ + #define PIPE_TOTAL_PIPES 7 + + /** Size in bytes of the largest pipe bank size possible in the device. Not all banks on each AVR + * model supports the largest bank size possible on the device; different pipe numbers support + * different maximum bank sizes. This value reflects the largest possible bank of any pipe on the + * currently selected USB AVR model. + */ + #define PIPE_MAX_SIZE 256 + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible error return codes of the \ref Pipe_WaitUntilReady() function. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipeRW_AVR8 + */ + enum Pipe_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t + { + PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError = 0, /**< Pipe ready for next packet, no error. */ + PIPE_READYWAIT_PipeStalled = 1, /**< The device stalled the pipe while waiting. */ + PIPE_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected = 2, /**< Device was disconnected from the host while waiting. */ + PIPE_READYWAIT_Timeout = 3, /**< The device failed to accept or send the next packet + * within the software timeout period set by the + * \ref USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS macro. + */ + }; + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Indicates the number of bytes currently stored in the current pipes's selected bank. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipeRW_AVR8 + * + * \return Total number of bytes in the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint16_t Pipe_BytesInPipe(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint16_t Pipe_BytesInPipe(void) + { + return UPBCX; + } + + /** Determines the currently selected pipe's direction. + * + * \return The currently selected pipe's direction, as a \c PIPE_DIR_* mask. + */ + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetPipeDirection(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetPipeDirection(void) + { + return (UPCFG0X & (1 << EPDIR)) ? PIPE_DIR_IN : PIPE_DIR_OUT; + } + + /** Returns the pipe address of the currently selected pipe. This is typically used to save the + * currently selected pipe address so that it can be restored after another pipe has been manipulated. + * + * \return Index of the currently selected pipe. + */ + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetCurrentPipe(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetCurrentPipe(void) + { + return ((UPNUM & PIPE_PIPENUM_MASK) | Pipe_GetPipeDirection()); + } + + /** Selects the given pipe address. Any pipe operations which do not require the pipe address to be + * indicated will operate on the currently selected pipe. + * + * \param[in] Address Address of the pipe to select. + */ + static inline void Pipe_SelectPipe(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_SelectPipe(const uint8_t Address) + { + UPNUM = (Address & PIPE_PIPENUM_MASK); + } + + /** Resets the desired pipe, including the pipe banks and flags. + * + * \param[in] Address Address of the pipe to reset. + */ + static inline void Pipe_ResetPipe(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_ResetPipe(const uint8_t Address) + { + UPRST = (1 << (Address & PIPE_PIPENUM_MASK)); + UPRST = 0; + } + + /** Enables the currently selected pipe so that data can be sent and received through it to and from + * an attached device. + * + * \pre The currently selected pipe must first be configured properly via \ref Pipe_ConfigurePipe(). + */ + static inline void Pipe_EnablePipe(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_EnablePipe(void) + { + UPCONX |= (1 << PEN); + } + + /** Disables the currently selected pipe so that data cannot be sent and received through it to and + * from an attached device. + */ + static inline void Pipe_DisablePipe(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_DisablePipe(void) + { + UPCONX &= ~(1 << PEN); + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected pipe is enabled, but not necessarily configured. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the currently selected pipe is enabled, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsEnabled(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsEnabled(void) + { + return ((UPCONX & (1 << PEN)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Gets the current pipe token, indicating the pipe's data direction and type. + * + * \return The current pipe token, as a \c PIPE_TOKEN_* mask. + */ + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetPipeToken(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetPipeToken(void) + { + return (UPCFG0X & (0x03 << PTOKEN0)); + } + + /** Sets the token for the currently selected pipe to one of the tokens specified by the \c PIPE_TOKEN_* + * masks. This can be used on CONTROL type pipes, to allow for bidirectional transfer of data during + * control requests, or on regular pipes to allow for half-duplex bidirectional data transfer to devices + * which have two endpoints of opposite direction sharing the same endpoint address within the device. + * + * \param[in] Token New pipe token to set the selected pipe to, as a \c PIPE_TOKEN_* mask. + */ + static inline void Pipe_SetPipeToken(const uint8_t Token) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_SetPipeToken(const uint8_t Token) + { + UPCFG0X = ((UPCFG0X & ~(0x03 << PTOKEN0)) | Token); + } + + /** Configures the currently selected pipe to allow for an unlimited number of IN requests. */ + static inline void Pipe_SetInfiniteINRequests(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_SetInfiniteINRequests(void) + { + UPCONX |= (1 << INMODE); + } + + /** Configures the currently selected pipe to only allow the specified number of IN requests to be + * accepted by the pipe before it is automatically frozen. + * + * \param[in] TotalINRequests Total number of IN requests that the pipe may receive before freezing. + */ + static inline void Pipe_SetFiniteINRequests(const uint8_t TotalINRequests) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_SetFiniteINRequests(const uint8_t TotalINRequests) + { + UPCONX &= ~(1 << INMODE); + UPINRQX = TotalINRequests; + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected pipe is configured. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the selected pipe is configured, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsConfigured(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsConfigured(void) + { + return ((UPSTAX & (1 << CFGOK)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Retrieves the endpoint address of the endpoint within the attached device that the currently selected + * pipe is bound to. + * + * \return Endpoint address the currently selected pipe is bound to. + */ + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress(void) + { + uint8_t UPCFG0X_Temp = UPCFG0X; + + return (((UPCFG0X_Temp >> PEPNUM0) & PIPE_EPNUM_MASK) | + ((UPCFG0X_Temp & (1 << PTOKEN1)) ? ENDPOINT_DIR_IN : ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT)); + } + + /** Sets the period between interrupts for an INTERRUPT type pipe to a specified number of milliseconds. + * + * \param[in] Milliseconds Number of milliseconds between each pipe poll. + */ + static inline void Pipe_SetInterruptPeriod(const uint8_t Milliseconds) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_SetInterruptPeriod(const uint8_t Milliseconds) + { + UPCFG2X = Milliseconds; + } + + /** Returns a mask indicating which pipe's interrupt periods have elapsed, indicating that the pipe should + * be serviced. + * + * \return Mask whose bits indicate which pipes have interrupted. + */ + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetPipeInterrupts(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetPipeInterrupts(void) + { + return UPINT; + } + + /** Determines if the specified pipe address has interrupted (valid only for INTERRUPT type + * pipes). + * + * \param[in] Address Address of the pipe whose interrupt flag should be tested. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the specified pipe has interrupted, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_HasPipeInterrupted(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_HasPipeInterrupted(const uint8_t Address) + { + return ((UPINT & (1 << (Address & PIPE_PIPENUM_MASK))) ? true : false); + } + + /** Unfreezes the selected pipe, allowing it to communicate with an attached device. */ + static inline void Pipe_Unfreeze(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Unfreeze(void) + { + UPCONX &= ~(1 << PFREEZE); + } + + /** Freezes the selected pipe, preventing it from communicating with an attached device. */ + static inline void Pipe_Freeze(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Freeze(void) + { + UPCONX |= (1 << PFREEZE); + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected pipe is frozen, and not able to accept data. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the currently selected pipe is frozen, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsFrozen(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsFrozen(void) + { + return ((UPCONX & (1 << PFREEZE)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Clears the error flags for the currently selected pipe. */ + static inline void Pipe_ClearError(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_ClearError(void) + { + UPERRX = 0; + UPINTX &= ~(1 << PERRI); + } + + /** Determines if the master pipe error flag is set for the currently selected pipe, indicating that + * some sort of hardware error has occurred on the pipe. + * + * \see \ref Pipe_GetErrorFlags() macro for information on retrieving the exact error flag. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if an error has occurred on the selected pipe, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsError(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsError(void) + { + return ((UPINTX & (1 << PERRI)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Gets a mask of the hardware error flags which have occurred on the currently selected pipe. This + * value can then be masked against the \c PIPE_ERRORFLAG_* masks to determine what error has occurred. + * + * \return Mask comprising of \c PIPE_ERRORFLAG_* bits indicating what error has occurred on the selected pipe. + */ + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetErrorFlags(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetErrorFlags(void) + { + return ((UPERRX & (PIPE_ERRORFLAG_CRC16 | PIPE_ERRORFLAG_TIMEOUT | + PIPE_ERRORFLAG_PID | PIPE_ERRORFLAG_DATAPID | + PIPE_ERRORFLAG_DATATGL)) | + (UPSTAX & (PIPE_ERRORFLAG_OVERFLOW | PIPE_ERRORFLAG_UNDERFLOW))); + } + + /** Retrieves the number of busy banks in the currently selected pipe, which have been queued for + * transmission via the \ref Pipe_ClearOUT() command, or are awaiting acknowledgement via the + * \ref Pipe_ClearIN() command. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_AVR8 + * + * \return Total number of busy banks in the selected pipe. + */ + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetBusyBanks(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetBusyBanks(void) + { + return (UPSTAX & (0x03 << NBUSYBK0)); + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected pipe may be read from (if data is waiting in the pipe + * bank and the pipe is an IN direction, or if the bank is not yet full if the pipe is an OUT + * direction). This function will return false if an error has occurred in the pipe, or if the pipe + * is an IN direction and no packet (or an empty packet) has been received, or if the pipe is an OUT + * direction and the pipe bank is full. + * + * \note This function is not valid on CONTROL type pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_AVR8 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the currently selected pipe may be read from or written to, depending + * on its direction. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed(void) + { + return ((UPINTX & (1 << RWAL)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Determines if a packet has been received on the currently selected IN pipe from the attached device. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_AVR8 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the current pipe has received an IN packet, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsINReceived(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsINReceived(void) + { + return ((UPINTX & (1 << RXINI)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected OUT pipe is ready to send an OUT packet to the attached device. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_AVR8 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the current pipe is ready for an OUT packet, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsOUTReady(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsOUTReady(void) + { + return ((UPINTX & (1 << TXOUTI)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Determines if no SETUP request is currently being sent to the attached device on the selected + * CONTROL type pipe. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_AVR8 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the current pipe is ready for a SETUP packet, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsSETUPSent(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsSETUPSent(void) + { + return ((UPINTX & (1 << TXSTPI)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Sends the currently selected CONTROL type pipe's contents to the device as a SETUP packet. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_AVR8 + */ + static inline void Pipe_ClearSETUP(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_ClearSETUP(void) + { + UPINTX &= ~((1 << TXSTPI) | (1 << FIFOCON)); + } + + /** Acknowledges the reception of a setup IN request from the attached device on the currently selected + * pipe, freeing the bank ready for the next packet. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_AVR8 + */ + static inline void Pipe_ClearIN(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_ClearIN(void) + { + UPINTX &= ~((1 << RXINI) | (1 << FIFOCON)); + } + + /** Sends the currently selected pipe's contents to the device as an OUT packet on the selected pipe, freeing + * the bank ready for the next packet. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_AVR8 + */ + static inline void Pipe_ClearOUT(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_ClearOUT(void) + { + UPINTX &= ~((1 << TXOUTI) | (1 << FIFOCON)); + } + + /** Determines if the device sent a NAK (Negative Acknowledge) in response to the last sent packet on + * the currently selected pipe. This occurs when the host sends a packet to the device, but the device + * is not currently ready to handle the packet (i.e. its endpoint banks are full). Once a NAK has been + * received, it must be cleared using \ref Pipe_ClearNAKReceived() before the previous (or any other) packet + * can be re-sent. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_AVR8 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if an NAK has been received on the current pipe, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsNAKReceived(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsNAKReceived(void) + { + return ((UPINTX & (1 << NAKEDI)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Clears the NAK condition on the currently selected pipe. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_AVR8 + * + * \see \ref Pipe_IsNAKReceived() for more details. + */ + static inline void Pipe_ClearNAKReceived(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_ClearNAKReceived(void) + { + UPINTX &= ~(1 << NAKEDI); + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected pipe has had the STALL condition set by the attached device. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_AVR8 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the current pipe has been stalled by the attached device, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsStalled(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsStalled(void) + { + return ((UPINTX & (1 << RXSTALLI)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Clears the STALL condition detection flag on the currently selected pipe, but does not clear the + * STALL condition itself (this must be done via a ClearFeature control request to the device). + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_AVR8 + */ + static inline void Pipe_ClearStall(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_ClearStall(void) + { + UPINTX &= ~(1 << RXSTALLI); + } + + /** Reads one byte from the currently selected pipe's bank, for OUT direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \return Next byte in the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint8_t Pipe_Read_8(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Pipe_Read_8(void) + { + return UPDATX; + } + + /** Writes one byte to the currently selected pipe's bank, for IN direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write into the the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Pipe_Write_8(const uint8_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Write_8(const uint8_t Data) + { + UPDATX = Data; + } + + /** Discards one byte from the currently selected pipe's bank, for OUT direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_AVR8 + */ + static inline void Pipe_Discard_8(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Discard_8(void) + { + uint8_t Dummy; + + Dummy = UPDATX; + + (void)Dummy; + } + + /** Reads two bytes from the currently selected pipe's bank in little endian format, for OUT + * direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \return Next two bytes in the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint16_t Pipe_Read_16_LE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint16_t Pipe_Read_16_LE(void) + { + union + { + uint16_t Value; + uint8_t Bytes[2]; + } Data; + + Data.Bytes[0] = UPDATX; + Data.Bytes[1] = UPDATX; + + return Data.Value; + } + + /** Reads two bytes from the currently selected pipe's bank in big endian format, for OUT + * direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \return Next two bytes in the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint16_t Pipe_Read_16_BE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint16_t Pipe_Read_16_BE(void) + { + union + { + uint16_t Value; + uint8_t Bytes[2]; + } Data; + + Data.Bytes[1] = UPDATX; + Data.Bytes[0] = UPDATX; + + return Data.Value; + } + + /** Writes two bytes to the currently selected pipe's bank in little endian format, for IN + * direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Pipe_Write_16_LE(const uint16_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Write_16_LE(const uint16_t Data) + { + UPDATX = (Data & 0xFF); + UPDATX = (Data >> 8); + } + + /** Writes two bytes to the currently selected pipe's bank in big endian format, for IN + * direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Pipe_Write_16_BE(const uint16_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Write_16_BE(const uint16_t Data) + { + UPDATX = (Data >> 8); + UPDATX = (Data & 0xFF); + } + + /** Discards two bytes from the currently selected pipe's bank, for OUT direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_AVR8 + */ + static inline void Pipe_Discard_16(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Discard_16(void) + { + uint8_t Dummy; + + Dummy = UPDATX; + Dummy = UPDATX; + + (void)Dummy; + } + + /** Reads four bytes from the currently selected pipe's bank in little endian format, for OUT + * direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \return Next four bytes in the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint32_t Pipe_Read_32_LE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint32_t Pipe_Read_32_LE(void) + { + union + { + uint32_t Value; + uint8_t Bytes[4]; + } Data; + + Data.Bytes[0] = UPDATX; + Data.Bytes[1] = UPDATX; + Data.Bytes[2] = UPDATX; + Data.Bytes[3] = UPDATX; + + return Data.Value; + } + + /** Reads four bytes from the currently selected pipe's bank in big endian format, for OUT + * direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \return Next four bytes in the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint32_t Pipe_Read_32_BE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint32_t Pipe_Read_32_BE(void) + { + union + { + uint32_t DWord; + uint8_t Bytes[4]; + } Data; + + Data.Bytes[3] = UPDATX; + Data.Bytes[2] = UPDATX; + Data.Bytes[1] = UPDATX; + Data.Bytes[0] = UPDATX; + + return Data.DWord; + } + + /** Writes four bytes to the currently selected pipe's bank in little endian format, for IN + * direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Pipe_Write_32_LE(const uint32_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Write_32_LE(const uint32_t Data) + { + UPDATX = (Data & 0xFF); + UPDATX = (Data >> 8); + UPDATX = (Data >> 16); + UPDATX = (Data >> 24); + } + + /** Writes four bytes to the currently selected pipe's bank in big endian format, for IN + * direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_AVR8 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Pipe_Write_32_BE(const uint32_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Write_32_BE(const uint32_t Data) + { + UPDATX = (Data >> 24); + UPDATX = (Data >> 16); + UPDATX = (Data >> 8); + UPDATX = (Data & 0xFF); + } + + /** Discards four bytes from the currently selected pipe's bank, for OUT direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_AVR8 + */ + static inline void Pipe_Discard_32(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Discard_32(void) + { + uint8_t Dummy; + + Dummy = UPDATX; + Dummy = UPDATX; + Dummy = UPDATX; + Dummy = UPDATX; + + (void)Dummy; + } + + /* External Variables: */ + /** Global indicating the maximum packet size of the default control pipe located at address + * 0 in the device. This value is set to the value indicated in the attached device's device + * descriptor once the USB interface is initialized into host mode and a device is attached + * to the USB bus. + * + * \attention This variable should be treated as read-only in the user application, and never manually + * changed in value. + */ + extern uint8_t USB_Host_ControlPipeSize; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Configures a table of pipe descriptions, in sequence. This function can be used to configure multiple + * pipes at the same time. + * + * \note Pipe with a zero address will be ignored, thus this function cannot be used to configure the + * control pipe. + * + * \param[in] Table Pointer to a table of pipe descriptions. + * \param[in] Entries Number of entries in the pipe table to configure. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if all pipes configured successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(const USB_Pipe_Table_t* const Table, + const uint8_t Entries); + + /** Configures the specified pipe address with the given pipe type, endpoint address within the attached device, + * bank size and number of hardware banks. + * + * A newly configured pipe is frozen by default, and must be unfrozen before use via the \ref Pipe_Unfreeze() + * before being used. Pipes should be kept frozen unless waiting for data from a device while in IN mode, or + * sending data to the device in OUT mode. IN type pipes are also automatically configured to accept infinite + * numbers of IN requests without automatic freezing - this can be overridden by a call to + * \ref Pipe_SetFiniteINRequests(). + * + * \param[in] Address Pipe address to configure. + * + * \param[in] Type Type of pipe to configure, an \c EP_TYPE_* mask. Not all pipe types are available on Low + * Speed USB devices - refer to the USB 2.0 specification. + * + * \param[in] EndpointAddress Endpoint address within the attached device that the pipe should interface to. + * + * \param[in] Size Size of the pipe's bank, where packets are stored before they are transmitted to + * the USB device, or after they have been received from the USB device (depending on + * the pipe's data direction). The bank size must indicate the maximum packet size that + * the pipe can handle. + * + * \param[in] Banks Number of banks to use for the pipe being configured. + * + * \attention When the \c ORDERED_EP_CONFIG compile time option is used, Pipes <b>must</b> be configured in ascending order, + * or bank corruption will occur. + * + * \note Certain microcontroller model's pipes may have different maximum packet sizes based on the pipe's + * index - refer to the chosen microcontroller's datasheet to determine the maximum bank size for each pipe. + * \n\n + * + * \note The default control pipe should not be manually configured by the user application, as it is + * automatically configured by the library internally. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine will automatically select the specified pipe upon success. Upon failure, the pipe which + * failed to reconfigure correctly will be selected. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the configuration succeeded, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool Pipe_ConfigurePipe(const uint8_t Address, + const uint8_t Type, + const uint8_t EndpointAddress, + const uint16_t Size, + const uint8_t Banks); + + /** Spin-loops until the currently selected non-control pipe is ready for the next packet of data to be read + * or written to it, aborting in the case of an error condition (such as a timeout or device disconnect). + * + * \ingroup Group_PipeRW_AVR8 + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_WaitUntilReady(void); + + /** Determines if a pipe has been bound to the given device endpoint address. If a pipe which is bound to the given + * endpoint is found, it is automatically selected. + * + * \param[in] EndpointAddress Address and direction mask of the endpoint within the attached device to check. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if a pipe bound to the given endpoint address of the specified direction is found, + * \c false otherwise. + */ + bool Pipe_IsEndpointBound(const uint8_t EndpointAddress) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #if !defined(ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP) + #define ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP 0 + #endif + + /* Inline Functions: */ + static inline uint8_t Pipe_BytesToEPSizeMask(const uint16_t Bytes) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_CONST ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Pipe_BytesToEPSizeMask(const uint16_t Bytes) + { + uint8_t MaskVal = 0; + uint16_t CheckBytes = 8; + + while ((CheckBytes < Bytes) && (CheckBytes < PIPE_MAX_SIZE)) + { + MaskVal++; + CheckBytes <<= 1; + } + + return (MaskVal << EPSIZE0); + } + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void Pipe_ClearPipes(void); + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f6c4beb229 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c @@ -0,0 +1,84 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#if defined(TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME) + +uint8_t TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME (void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) +{ + uint8_t* DataStream = ((uint8_t*)Buffer + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length)); + + if (!(Length)) + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + while (Length) + { + uint8_t USB_DeviceState_LCL = USB_DeviceState; + + if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + else if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Suspended) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_BusSuspended; + else if (Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived()) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_HostAborted; + + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + { + while (Length && Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint()) + { + TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(DataStream); + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(DataStream, 1); + Length--; + } + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + } + + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) + { + uint8_t USB_DeviceState_LCL = USB_DeviceState; + + if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + else if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Suspended) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_BusSuspended; + } + + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_NoError; +} + +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE +#undef TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME +#undef TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..922b58efa3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c @@ -0,0 +1,95 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#if defined(TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME) + +uint8_t TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME (const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) +{ + uint8_t* DataStream = ((uint8_t*)Buffer + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length)); + bool LastPacketFull = false; + + if (Length > USB_ControlRequest.wLength) + Length = USB_ControlRequest.wLength; + else if (!(Length)) + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + while (Length || LastPacketFull) + { + uint8_t USB_DeviceState_LCL = USB_DeviceState; + + if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + else if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Suspended) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_BusSuspended; + else if (Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived()) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_HostAborted; + else if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + break; + + if (Endpoint_IsINReady()) + { + uint16_t BytesInEndpoint = Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint(); + + while (Length && (BytesInEndpoint < USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize)) + { + TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(DataStream); + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(DataStream, 1); + Length--; + BytesInEndpoint++; + } + + LastPacketFull = (BytesInEndpoint == USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } + } + + while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) + { + uint8_t USB_DeviceState_LCL = USB_DeviceState; + + if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + else if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Suspended) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_BusSuspended; + else if (Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived()) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_HostAborted; + } + + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_NoError; +} + +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE +#undef TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME +#undef TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e55e592eb2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c @@ -0,0 +1,89 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#if defined(TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME) + +uint8_t TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME (TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) +{ + uint8_t* DataStream = ((uint8_t*)Buffer + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length)); + uint16_t BytesInTransfer = 0; + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + Length -= *BytesProcessed; + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(DataStream, *BytesProcessed); + } + + while (Length) + { + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT(); + + #if !defined(INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT) + USB_USBTask(); + #endif + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + *BytesProcessed += BytesInTransfer; + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + } + else + { + TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(DataStream); + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(DataStream, 1); + Length--; + BytesInTransfer++; + } + } + + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +#undef TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE +#undef TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE +#undef TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bb2a57fa52 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c @@ -0,0 +1,88 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#if defined(TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME) + +uint8_t TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME (TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) +{ + uint8_t* DataStream = ((uint8_t*)Buffer + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length)); + uint16_t BytesInTransfer = 0; + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SetPipeToken(TEMPLATE_TOKEN); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + Length -= *BytesProcessed; + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(DataStream, *BytesProcessed); + } + + while (Length) + { + if (!(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + TEMPLATE_CLEAR_PIPE(); + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + *BytesProcessed += BytesInTransfer; + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + } + else + { + TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(DataStream); + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(DataStream, 1); + Length--; + BytesInTransfer++; + } + } + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +#undef TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE +#undef TEMPLATE_TOKEN +#undef TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE +#undef TEMPLATE_CLEAR_PIPE +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/USBController_AVR8.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/USBController_AVR8.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..92532ab00b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/USBController_AVR8.c @@ -0,0 +1,273 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_CONTROLLER_C +#include "../USBController.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) +volatile uint8_t USB_CurrentMode = USB_MODE_None; +#endif + +#if !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS) +volatile uint8_t USB_Options; +#endif + +void USB_Init( + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + const uint8_t Mode + #endif + + #if (defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) && !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS)) + , + #elif (!defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) && defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS)) + void + #endif + + #if !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS) + const uint8_t Options + #endif + ) +{ + #if !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS) + USB_Options = Options; + #endif + + #if defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR) + /* Workaround for AVR8 bootloaders that fail to turn off the OTG pad before running + * the loaded application. This causes VBUS detection to fail unless we first force + * it off to reset it. */ + USB_OTGPAD_Off(); + #endif + + if (!(USB_Options & USB_OPT_REG_DISABLED)) + USB_REG_On(); + else + USB_REG_Off(); + + if (!(USB_Options & USB_OPT_MANUAL_PLL)) + { + #if defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) + PLLFRQ = (1 << PDIV2); + #endif + } + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + if (Mode == USB_MODE_UID) + { + UHWCON |= (1 << UIDE); + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_IDTI); + USB_CurrentMode = USB_GetUSBModeFromUID(); + } + else + { + UHWCON &= ~(1 << UIDE); + USB_CurrentMode = Mode; + } + #endif + + USB_IsInitialized = true; + + USB_ResetInterface(); +} + +void USB_Disable(void) +{ + USB_INT_DisableAllInterrupts(); + USB_INT_ClearAllInterrupts(); + + USB_Detach(); + USB_Controller_Disable(); + + if (!(USB_Options & USB_OPT_MANUAL_PLL)) + USB_PLL_Off(); + + if (!(USB_Options & USB_OPT_REG_KEEP_ENABLED)) + USB_REG_Off(); + + #if defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR) + USB_OTGPAD_Off(); + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + USB_CurrentMode = USB_MODE_None; + #endif + + USB_IsInitialized = false; +} + +void USB_ResetInterface(void) +{ + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + bool UIDModeSelectEnabled = ((UHWCON & (1 << UIDE)) != 0); + #endif + + USB_INT_DisableAllInterrupts(); + USB_INT_ClearAllInterrupts(); + + USB_Controller_Reset(); + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + if (UIDModeSelectEnabled) + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_IDTI); + #endif + + USB_CLK_Unfreeze(); + + if (USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Device) + { + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + #if (defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR)) + UHWCON |= (1 << UIMOD); + #endif + + if (!(USB_Options & USB_OPT_MANUAL_PLL)) + { + #if defined(USB_SERIES_2_AVR) + USB_PLL_On(); + while (!(USB_PLL_IsReady())); + #else + USB_PLL_Off(); + #endif + } + + USB_Init_Device(); + #endif + } + else if (USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Host) + { + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + UHWCON &= ~(1 << UIMOD); + + if (!(USB_Options & USB_OPT_MANUAL_PLL)) + { + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + USB_PLL_On(); + while (!(USB_PLL_IsReady())); + #endif + } + + USB_Init_Host(); + #endif + } + + #if (defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR)) + USB_OTGPAD_On(); + #endif +} + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) +static void USB_Init_Device(void) +{ + USB_DeviceState = DEVICE_STATE_Unattached; + USB_Device_ConfigurationNumber = 0; + + #if !defined(NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP) + USB_Device_RemoteWakeupEnabled = false; + #endif + + #if !defined(NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER) + USB_Device_CurrentlySelfPowered = false; + #endif + + #if !defined(FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE) + USB_Descriptor_Device_t* DeviceDescriptorPtr; + + #if defined(ARCH_HAS_MULTI_ADDRESS_SPACE) && \ + !(defined(USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS) || defined(USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS) || defined(USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS)) + uint8_t DescriptorAddressSpace; + + if (CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor((DTYPE_Device << 8), 0, (void*)&DeviceDescriptorPtr, &DescriptorAddressSpace) != NO_DESCRIPTOR) + { + if (DescriptorAddressSpace == MEMSPACE_FLASH) + USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize = pgm_read_byte(&DeviceDescriptorPtr->Endpoint0Size); + else if (DescriptorAddressSpace == MEMSPACE_EEPROM) + USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize = eeprom_read_byte(&DeviceDescriptorPtr->Endpoint0Size); + else + USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize = DeviceDescriptorPtr->Endpoint0Size; + } + #else + if (CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor((DTYPE_Device << 8), 0, (void*)&DeviceDescriptorPtr) != NO_DESCRIPTOR) + { + #if defined(USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS) + USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize = DeviceDescriptorPtr->Endpoint0Size; + #elif defined(USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS) + USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize = eeprom_read_byte(&DeviceDescriptorPtr->Endpoint0Size); + #else + USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize = pgm_read_byte(&DeviceDescriptorPtr->Endpoint0Size); + #endif + } + #endif + #endif + + #if (defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR)) + if (USB_Options & USB_DEVICE_OPT_LOWSPEED) + USB_Device_SetLowSpeed(); + else + USB_Device_SetFullSpeed(); + + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_VBUSTI); + #endif + + Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP, EP_TYPE_CONTROL, + USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize, 1); + + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_SUSPI); + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_SUSPI); + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_EORSTI); + + USB_Attach(); +} +#endif + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) +static void USB_Init_Host(void) +{ + USB_HostState = HOST_STATE_Unattached; + USB_Host_ConfigurationNumber = 0; + USB_Host_ControlPipeSize = PIPE_CONTROLPIPE_DEFAULT_SIZE; + + USB_Host_HostMode_On(); + + USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_Off(); + USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_Enable(); + USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_On(); + + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_SRPI); + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_BCERRI); + + USB_Attach(); +} +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/USBController_AVR8.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/USBController_AVR8.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1b6e2ef43c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/USBController_AVR8.h @@ -0,0 +1,432 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Controller definitions for the AVR8 microcontrollers. + * \copydetails Group_USBManagement_AVR8 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBManagement + * \defgroup Group_USBManagement_AVR8 USB Interface Management (AVR8) + * \brief USB Controller definitions for the AVR8 microcontrollers. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to the setup and management of the USB interface. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __USBCONTROLLER_AVR8_H__ +#define __USBCONTROLLER_AVR8_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../USBMode.h" + #include "../Events.h" + #include "../USBTask.h" + #include "../USBInterrupt.h" + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #include "../Host.h" + #include "../OTG.h" + #include "../Pipe.h" + #include "../HostStandardReq.h" + #include "../PipeStream.h" + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #include "../Device.h" + #include "../Endpoint.h" + #include "../DeviceStandardReq.h" + #include "../EndpointStream.h" + #endif + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks and Defines: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + #if !defined(F_USB) + #error F_USB is not defined. You must define F_USB to the frequency of the unprescaled USB controller clock in your project makefile. + #endif + + #if (F_USB == 8000000) + #if (defined(__AVR_AT90USB82__) || defined(__AVR_AT90USB162__) || \ + defined(__AVR_ATmega8U2__) || defined(__AVR_ATmega16U2__) || \ + defined(__AVR_ATmega32U2__)) + #define USB_PLL_PSC 0 + #elif (defined(__AVR_ATmega16U4__) || defined(__AVR_ATmega32U4__)) + #define USB_PLL_PSC 0 + #elif (defined(__AVR_AT90USB646__) || defined(__AVR_AT90USB1286__)) + #define USB_PLL_PSC ((1 << PLLP1) | (1 << PLLP0)) + #elif (defined(__AVR_AT90USB647__) || defined(__AVR_AT90USB1287__)) + #define USB_PLL_PSC ((1 << PLLP1) | (1 << PLLP0)) + #endif + #elif (F_USB == 16000000) + #if (defined(__AVR_AT90USB82__) || defined(__AVR_AT90USB162__) || \ + defined(__AVR_ATmega8U2__) || defined(__AVR_ATmega16U2__) || \ + defined(__AVR_ATmega32U2__)) + #define USB_PLL_PSC (1 << PLLP0) + #elif (defined(__AVR_ATmega16U4__) || defined(__AVR_ATmega32U4__)) + #define USB_PLL_PSC (1 << PINDIV) + #elif (defined(__AVR_AT90USB646__) || defined(__AVR_AT90USB647__)) + #define USB_PLL_PSC ((1 << PLLP2) | (1 << PLLP1)) + #elif (defined(__AVR_AT90USB1286__) || defined(__AVR_AT90USB1287__)) + #define USB_PLL_PSC ((1 << PLLP2) | (1 << PLLP0)) + #endif + #endif + + #if !defined(USB_PLL_PSC) + #error No PLL prescale value available for chosen F_USB value and AVR model. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** \name USB Controller Option Masks */ + //@{ + /** Regulator disable option mask for \ref USB_Init(). This indicates that the internal 3.3V USB data pad + * regulator should be disabled and the AVR's VCC level used for the data pads. + * + * \note See USB AVR data sheet for more information on the internal pad regulator. + */ + #define USB_OPT_REG_DISABLED (1 << 1) + + /** Regulator enable option mask for \ref USB_Init(). This indicates that the internal 3.3V USB data pad + * regulator should be enabled to regulate the data pin voltages from the VBUS level down to a level within + * the range allowable by the USB standard. + * + * \note See USB AVR data sheet for more information on the internal pad regulator. + */ + #define USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED (0 << 1) + + /** Option mask for \ref USB_Init() to keep regulator enabled at all times. Indicates that \ref USB_Disable() + * should not disable the regulator as it would otherwise. Has no effect if regulator is disabled using + * \ref USB_OPT_REG_DISABLED. + * + * \note See USB AVR data sheet for more information on the internal pad regulator. + */ + #define USB_OPT_REG_KEEP_ENABLED (1 << 3) + + /** Manual PLL control option mask for \ref USB_Init(). This indicates to the library that the user application + * will take full responsibility for controlling the AVR's PLL (used to generate the high frequency clock + * that the USB controller requires) and ensuring that it is locked at the correct frequency for USB operations. + */ + #define USB_OPT_MANUAL_PLL (1 << 2) + + /** Automatic PLL control option mask for \ref USB_Init(). This indicates to the library that the library should + * take full responsibility for controlling the AVR's PLL (used to generate the high frequency clock + * that the USB controller requires) and ensuring that it is locked at the correct frequency for USB operations. + */ + #define USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL (0 << 2) + //@} + + #if !defined(USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Constant for the maximum software timeout period of the USB data stream transfer functions + * (both control and standard) when in either device or host mode. If the next packet of a stream + * is not received or acknowledged within this time period, the stream function will fail. + * + * This value may be overridden in the user project makefile as the value of the + * \ref USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS token, and passed to the compiler using the -D switch. + */ + #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS 100 + #endif + + /* Inline Functions: */ + #if defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Determines if the VBUS line is currently high (i.e. the USB host is supplying power). + * + * \note This function is not available on some AVR models which do not support hardware VBUS monitoring. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the VBUS line is currently detecting power from a host, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool USB_VBUS_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool USB_VBUS_GetStatus(void) + { + return ((USBSTA & (1 << VBUS)) ? true : false); + } + #endif + + /** Detaches the device from the USB bus. This has the effect of removing the device from any + * attached host, ceasing USB communications. If no host is present, this prevents any host from + * enumerating the device once attached until \ref USB_Attach() is called. + */ + static inline void USB_Detach(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Detach(void) + { + UDCON |= (1 << DETACH); + } + + /** Attaches the device to the USB bus. This announces the device's presence to any attached + * USB host, starting the enumeration process. If no host is present, attaching the device + * will allow for enumeration once a host is connected to the device. + * + * This is inexplicably also required for proper operation while in host mode, to enable the + * attachment of a device to the host. This is despite the bit being located in the device-mode + * register and despite the datasheet making no mention of its requirement in host mode. + */ + static inline void USB_Attach(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Attach(void) + { + UDCON &= ~(1 << DETACH); + } + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Main function to initialize and start the USB interface. Once active, the USB interface will + * allow for device connection to a host when in device mode, or for device enumeration while in + * host mode. + * + * As the USB library relies on interrupts for the device and host mode enumeration processes, + * the user must enable global interrupts before or shortly after this function is called. In + * device mode, interrupts must be enabled within 500ms of this function being called to ensure + * that the host does not time out whilst enumerating the device. In host mode, interrupts may be + * enabled at the application's leisure however enumeration will not begin of an attached device + * until after this has occurred. + * + * Calling this function when the USB interface is already initialized will cause a complete USB + * interface reset and re-enumeration. + * + * \param[in] Mode Mask indicating what mode the USB interface is to be initialized to, a value + * from the \ref USB_Modes_t enum. + * \note This parameter does not exist on devices with only one supported USB + * mode (device or host). + * + * \param[in] Options Mask indicating the options which should be used when initializing the USB + * interface to control the USB interface's behavior. This should be comprised of + * a \c USB_OPT_REG_* mask to control the regulator, a \c USB_OPT_*_PLL mask to control the + * PLL, and a \c USB_DEVICE_OPT_* mask (when the device mode is enabled) to set the device + * mode speed. + * + * \note To reduce the FLASH requirements of the library if only device or host mode is required, + * the mode can be statically set in the project makefile by defining the token \c USB_DEVICE_ONLY + * (for device mode) or \c USB_HOST_ONLY (for host mode), passing the token to the compiler + * via the -D switch. If the mode is statically set, this parameter does not exist in the + * function prototype. + * \n\n + * + * \note To reduce the FLASH requirements of the library if only fixed settings are required, + * the options may be set statically in the same manner as the mode (see the Mode parameter of + * this function). To statically set the USB options, pass in the \c USE_STATIC_OPTIONS token, + * defined to the appropriate options masks. When the options are statically set, this + * parameter does not exist in the function prototype. + * \n\n + * + * \note The mode parameter does not exist on devices where only one mode is possible, such as USB + * AVR models which only implement the USB device mode in hardware. + * + * \see \ref Group_Device for the \c USB_DEVICE_OPT_* masks. + */ + void USB_Init( + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + const uint8_t Mode + #endif + + #if (defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) && !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS)) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + , + #elif (!defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) && defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS)) + void + #endif + + #if !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + const uint8_t Options + #endif + ); + + /** Shuts down the USB interface. This turns off the USB interface after deallocating all USB FIFO + * memory, endpoints and pipes. When turned off, no USB functionality can be used until the interface + * is restarted with the \ref USB_Init() function. + */ + void USB_Disable(void); + + /** Resets the interface, when already initialized. This will re-enumerate the device if already connected + * to a host, or re-enumerate an already attached device when in host mode. + */ + void USB_ResetInterface(void); + + /* Global Variables: */ + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Indicates the mode that the USB interface is currently initialized to, a value from the + * \ref USB_Modes_t enum. + * + * \attention This variable should be treated as read-only in the user application, and never manually + * changed in value. + * + * \note When the controller is initialized into UID auto-detection mode, this variable will hold the + * currently selected USB mode (i.e. \ref USB_MODE_Device or \ref USB_MODE_Host). If the controller + * is fixed into a specific mode (either through the \c USB_DEVICE_ONLY or \c USB_HOST_ONLY compile time + * options, or a limitation of the USB controller in the chosen device model) this will evaluate to + * a constant of the appropriate value and will never evaluate to \ref USB_MODE_None even when the + * USB interface is not initialized. + */ + extern volatile uint8_t USB_CurrentMode; + #elif defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + #define USB_CurrentMode USB_MODE_Host + #elif defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + #define USB_CurrentMode USB_MODE_Device + #endif + + #if !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Indicates the current USB options that the USB interface was initialized with when \ref USB_Init() + * was called. This value will be one of the \c USB_MODE_* masks defined elsewhere in this module. + * + * \attention This variable should be treated as read-only in the user application, and never manually + * changed in value. + */ + extern volatile uint8_t USB_Options; + #elif defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS) + #define USB_Options USE_STATIC_OPTIONS + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_CONTROLLER_C) + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + static void USB_Init_Device(void); + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + static void USB_Init_Host(void); + #endif + #endif + + /* Inline Functions: */ + static inline void USB_PLL_On(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_PLL_On(void) + { + PLLCSR = USB_PLL_PSC; + PLLCSR = (USB_PLL_PSC | (1 << PLLE)); + } + + static inline void USB_PLL_Off(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_PLL_Off(void) + { + PLLCSR = 0; + } + + static inline bool USB_PLL_IsReady(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool USB_PLL_IsReady(void) + { + return ((PLLCSR & (1 << PLOCK)) ? true : false); + } + + static inline void USB_REG_On(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_REG_On(void) + { + #if defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR) + UHWCON |= (1 << UVREGE); + #else + REGCR &= ~(1 << REGDIS); + #endif + } + + static inline void USB_REG_Off(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_REG_Off(void) + { + #if defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR) + UHWCON &= ~(1 << UVREGE); + #else + REGCR |= (1 << REGDIS); + #endif + } + + #if defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR) + static inline void USB_OTGPAD_On(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_OTGPAD_On(void) + { + USBCON |= (1 << OTGPADE); + } + + static inline void USB_OTGPAD_Off(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_OTGPAD_Off(void) + { + USBCON &= ~(1 << OTGPADE); + } + #endif + + static inline void USB_CLK_Freeze(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_CLK_Freeze(void) + { + USBCON |= (1 << FRZCLK); + } + + static inline void USB_CLK_Unfreeze(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_CLK_Unfreeze(void) + { + USBCON &= ~(1 << FRZCLK); + } + + static inline void USB_Controller_Enable(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Controller_Enable(void) + { + USBCON |= (1 << USBE); + } + + static inline void USB_Controller_Disable(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Controller_Disable(void) + { + USBCON &= ~(1 << USBE); + } + + static inline void USB_Controller_Reset(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Controller_Reset(void) + { + USBCON &= ~(1 << USBE); + USBCON |= (1 << USBE); + } + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + static inline uint8_t USB_GetUSBModeFromUID(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t USB_GetUSBModeFromUID(void) + { + if (USBSTA & (1 << ID)) + return USB_MODE_Device; + else + return USB_MODE_Host; + } + #endif + + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/USBInterrupt_AVR8.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/USBInterrupt_AVR8.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fac4fb41ad --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/USBInterrupt_AVR8.c @@ -0,0 +1,279 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBInterrupt.h" + +void USB_INT_DisableAllInterrupts(void) +{ + #if defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR) + USBCON &= ~((1 << VBUSTE) | (1 << IDTE)); + #elif defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) + USBCON &= ~(1 << VBUSTE); + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + OTGIEN = 0; + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + UHIEN = 0; + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + UDIEN = 0; + #endif +} + +void USB_INT_ClearAllInterrupts(void) +{ + #if defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR) + USBINT = 0; + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + OTGINT = 0; + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + UHINT = 0; + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + UDINT = 0; + #endif +} + +ISR(USB_GEN_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + #if !defined(NO_SOF_EVENTS) + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_SOFI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_SOFI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_SOFI); + + EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(); + } + #endif + + #if defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR) + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_VBUSTI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_VBUSTI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_VBUSTI); + + if (USB_VBUS_GetStatus()) + { + if (!(USB_Options & USB_OPT_MANUAL_PLL)) + { + USB_PLL_On(); + while (!(USB_PLL_IsReady())); + } + + USB_DeviceState = DEVICE_STATE_Powered; + EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(); + } + else + { + if (!(USB_Options & USB_OPT_MANUAL_PLL)) + USB_PLL_Off(); + + USB_DeviceState = DEVICE_STATE_Unattached; + EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(); + } + } + #endif + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_SUSPI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_SUSPI)) + { + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_SUSPI); + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_WAKEUPI); + + USB_CLK_Freeze(); + + if (!(USB_Options & USB_OPT_MANUAL_PLL)) + USB_PLL_Off(); + + #if defined(USB_SERIES_2_AVR) && !defined(NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT) + USB_DeviceState = DEVICE_STATE_Unattached; + EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(); + #else + USB_DeviceState = DEVICE_STATE_Suspended; + EVENT_USB_Device_Suspend(); + #endif + } + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_WAKEUPI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_WAKEUPI)) + { + if (!(USB_Options & USB_OPT_MANUAL_PLL)) + { + USB_PLL_On(); + while (!(USB_PLL_IsReady())); + } + + USB_CLK_Unfreeze(); + + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_WAKEUPI); + + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_WAKEUPI); + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_SUSPI); + + if (USB_Device_ConfigurationNumber) + USB_DeviceState = DEVICE_STATE_Configured; + else + USB_DeviceState = (USB_Device_IsAddressSet()) ? DEVICE_STATE_Addressed : DEVICE_STATE_Powered; + + #if defined(USB_SERIES_2_AVR) && !defined(NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT) + EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(); + #else + EVENT_USB_Device_WakeUp(); + #endif + } + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_EORSTI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_EORSTI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_EORSTI); + + USB_DeviceState = DEVICE_STATE_Default; + USB_Device_ConfigurationNumber = 0; + + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_SUSPI); + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_SUSPI); + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_WAKEUPI); + + Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP, EP_TYPE_CONTROL, + USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize, 1); + + #if defined(INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT) + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_RXSTPI); + #endif + + EVENT_USB_Device_Reset(); + } + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + #if !defined(NO_SOF_EVENTS) + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_HSOFI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_HSOFI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_HSOFI); + + EVENT_USB_Host_StartOfFrame(); + } + #endif + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_DDISCI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_DDISCI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_DDISCI); + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_DCONNI); + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_DDISCI); + + EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(); + + USB_ResetInterface(); + } + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_VBERRI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_VBERRI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_VBERRI); + + USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_Off(); + USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_Off(); + + EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(HOST_ERROR_VBusVoltageDip); + EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(); + + USB_HostState = HOST_STATE_Unattached; + } + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_SRPI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_SRPI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_SRPI); + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_SRPI); + + EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(); + + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_DDISCI); + + USB_HostState = HOST_STATE_Powered; + } + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_BCERRI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_BCERRI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_BCERRI); + + EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(HOST_ENUMERROR_NoDeviceDetected, 0); + EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(); + + USB_ResetInterface(); + } + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_IDTI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_IDTI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_IDTI); + + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(); + + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Unattached) + EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(); + + USB_CurrentMode = USB_GetUSBModeFromUID(); + USB_ResetInterface(); + + EVENT_USB_UIDChange(); + } + #endif +} + +#if defined(INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT) && defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) +ISR(USB_COM_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + uint8_t PrevSelectedEndpoint = Endpoint_GetCurrentEndpoint(); + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP); + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_RXSTPI); + + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + USB_Device_ProcessControlRequest(); + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP); + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_RXSTPI); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(PrevSelectedEndpoint); +} +#endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/USBInterrupt_AVR8.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/USBInterrupt_AVR8.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1eeb019f20 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/USBInterrupt_AVR8.h @@ -0,0 +1,375 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Controller Interrupt definitions for the AVR8 microcontrollers. + * + * This file contains definitions required for the correct handling of low level USB service routine interrupts + * from the USB controller. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +#ifndef __USBINTERRUPT_AVR8_H__ +#define __USBINTERRUPT_AVR8_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Enums: */ + enum USB_Interrupts_t + { + #if (defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + USB_INT_VBUSTI = 0, + #endif + #if (defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + USB_INT_IDTI = 1, + #endif + #if (defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + USB_INT_WAKEUPI = 2, + USB_INT_SUSPI = 3, + USB_INT_EORSTI = 4, + USB_INT_SOFI = 5, + USB_INT_RXSTPI = 6, + #endif + #if (defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + USB_INT_HSOFI = 7, + USB_INT_DCONNI = 8, + USB_INT_DDISCI = 9, + USB_INT_RSTI = 10, + USB_INT_BCERRI = 11, + USB_INT_VBERRI = 12, + USB_INT_SRPI = 13, + #endif + }; + + /* Inline Functions: */ + static inline void USB_INT_Enable(const uint8_t Interrupt) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_INT_Enable(const uint8_t Interrupt) + { + switch (Interrupt) + { + #if (defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR)) + case USB_INT_VBUSTI: + USBCON |= (1 << VBUSTE); + break; + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + case USB_INT_IDTI: + USBCON |= (1 << IDTE); + break; + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + case USB_INT_WAKEUPI: + UDIEN |= (1 << WAKEUPE); + break; + case USB_INT_SUSPI: + UDIEN |= (1 << SUSPE); + break; + case USB_INT_EORSTI: + UDIEN |= (1 << EORSTE); + break; + case USB_INT_SOFI: + UDIEN |= (1 << SOFE); + break; + case USB_INT_RXSTPI: + UEIENX |= (1 << RXSTPE); + break; + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + case USB_INT_HSOFI: + UHIEN |= (1 << HSOFE); + break; + case USB_INT_DCONNI: + UHIEN |= (1 << DCONNE); + break; + case USB_INT_DDISCI: + UHIEN |= (1 << DDISCE); + break; + case USB_INT_RSTI: + UHIEN |= (1 << RSTE); + break; + case USB_INT_BCERRI: + OTGIEN |= (1 << BCERRE); + break; + case USB_INT_VBERRI: + OTGIEN |= (1 << VBERRE); + break; + case USB_INT_SRPI: + OTGIEN |= (1 << SRPE); + break; + #endif + default: + break; + } + } + + static inline void USB_INT_Disable(const uint8_t Interrupt) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_INT_Disable(const uint8_t Interrupt) + { + switch (Interrupt) + { + #if (defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR)) + case USB_INT_VBUSTI: + USBCON &= ~(1 << VBUSTE); + break; + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + case USB_INT_IDTI: + USBCON &= ~(1 << IDTE); + break; + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + case USB_INT_WAKEUPI: + UDIEN &= ~(1 << WAKEUPE); + break; + case USB_INT_SUSPI: + UDIEN &= ~(1 << SUSPE); + break; + case USB_INT_EORSTI: + UDIEN &= ~(1 << EORSTE); + break; + case USB_INT_SOFI: + UDIEN &= ~(1 << SOFE); + break; + case USB_INT_RXSTPI: + UEIENX &= ~(1 << RXSTPE); + break; + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + case USB_INT_HSOFI: + UHIEN &= ~(1 << HSOFE); + break; + case USB_INT_DCONNI: + UHIEN &= ~(1 << DCONNE); + break; + case USB_INT_DDISCI: + UHIEN &= ~(1 << DDISCE); + break; + case USB_INT_RSTI: + UHIEN &= ~(1 << RSTE); + break; + case USB_INT_BCERRI: + OTGIEN &= ~(1 << BCERRE); + break; + case USB_INT_VBERRI: + OTGIEN &= ~(1 << VBERRE); + break; + case USB_INT_SRPI: + OTGIEN &= ~(1 << SRPE); + break; + #endif + default: + break; + } + } + + static inline void USB_INT_Clear(const uint8_t Interrupt) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_INT_Clear(const uint8_t Interrupt) + { + switch (Interrupt) + { + #if (defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR)) + case USB_INT_VBUSTI: + USBINT &= ~(1 << VBUSTI); + break; + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + case USB_INT_IDTI: + USBINT &= ~(1 << IDTI); + break; + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + case USB_INT_WAKEUPI: + UDINT &= ~(1 << WAKEUPI); + break; + case USB_INT_SUSPI: + UDINT &= ~(1 << SUSPI); + break; + case USB_INT_EORSTI: + UDINT &= ~(1 << EORSTI); + break; + case USB_INT_SOFI: + UDINT &= ~(1 << SOFI); + break; + case USB_INT_RXSTPI: + UEINTX &= ~(1 << RXSTPI); + break; + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + case USB_INT_HSOFI: + UHINT &= ~(1 << HSOFI); + break; + case USB_INT_DCONNI: + UHINT &= ~(1 << DCONNI); + break; + case USB_INT_DDISCI: + UHINT &= ~(1 << DDISCI); + break; + case USB_INT_RSTI: + UHINT &= ~(1 << RSTI); + break; + case USB_INT_BCERRI: + OTGINT &= ~(1 << BCERRI); + break; + case USB_INT_VBERRI: + OTGINT &= ~(1 << VBERRI); + break; + case USB_INT_SRPI: + OTGINT &= ~(1 << SRPI); + break; + #endif + default: + break; + } + } + + static inline bool USB_INT_IsEnabled(const uint8_t Interrupt) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline bool USB_INT_IsEnabled(const uint8_t Interrupt) + { + switch (Interrupt) + { + #if (defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR)) + case USB_INT_VBUSTI: + return (USBCON & (1 << VBUSTE)); + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + case USB_INT_IDTI: + return (USBCON & (1 << IDTE)); + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + case USB_INT_WAKEUPI: + return (UDIEN & (1 << WAKEUPE)); + case USB_INT_SUSPI: + return (UDIEN & (1 << SUSPE)); + case USB_INT_EORSTI: + return (UDIEN & (1 << EORSTE)); + case USB_INT_SOFI: + return (UDIEN & (1 << SOFE)); + case USB_INT_RXSTPI: + return (UEIENX & (1 << RXSTPE)); + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + case USB_INT_HSOFI: + return (UHIEN & (1 << HSOFE)); + case USB_INT_DCONNI: + return (UHIEN & (1 << DCONNE)); + case USB_INT_DDISCI: + return (UHIEN & (1 << DDISCE)); + case USB_INT_RSTI: + return (UHIEN & (1 << RSTE)); + case USB_INT_BCERRI: + return (OTGIEN & (1 << BCERRE)); + case USB_INT_VBERRI: + return (OTGIEN & (1 << VBERRE)); + case USB_INT_SRPI: + return (OTGIEN & (1 << SRPE)); + #endif + default: + return false; + } + } + + static inline bool USB_INT_HasOccurred(const uint8_t Interrupt) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline bool USB_INT_HasOccurred(const uint8_t Interrupt) + { + switch (Interrupt) + { + #if (defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_6_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_7_AVR)) + case USB_INT_VBUSTI: + return (USBINT & (1 << VBUSTI)); + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + case USB_INT_IDTI: + return (USBINT & (1 << IDTI)); + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + case USB_INT_WAKEUPI: + return (UDINT & (1 << WAKEUPI)); + case USB_INT_SUSPI: + return (UDINT & (1 << SUSPI)); + case USB_INT_EORSTI: + return (UDINT & (1 << EORSTI)); + case USB_INT_SOFI: + return (UDINT & (1 << SOFI)); + case USB_INT_RXSTPI: + return (UEINTX & (1 << RXSTPI)); + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + case USB_INT_HSOFI: + return (UHINT & (1 << HSOFI)); + case USB_INT_DCONNI: + return (UHINT & (1 << DCONNI)); + case USB_INT_DDISCI: + return (UHINT & (1 << DDISCI)); + case USB_INT_RSTI: + return (UHINT & (1 << RSTI)); + case USB_INT_BCERRI: + return (OTGINT & (1 << BCERRI)); + case USB_INT_VBERRI: + return (OTGINT & (1 << VBERRI)); + case USB_INT_SRPI: + return (OTGINT & (1 << SRPI)); + #endif + default: + return false; + } + } + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../USBMode.h" + #include "../Events.h" + #include "../USBController.h" + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void USB_INT_ClearAllInterrupts(void); + void USB_INT_DisableAllInterrupts(void); + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/ConfigDescriptors.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/ConfigDescriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d540bcfb4f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/ConfigDescriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,146 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "ConfigDescriptors.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) +uint8_t USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(const uint8_t ConfigNumber, + uint16_t* const ConfigSizePtr, + void* const BufferPtr, + const uint16_t BufferSize) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + uint8_t ConfigHeader[sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t)]; + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_DEVICE), + .bRequest = REQ_GetDescriptor, + .wValue = ((DTYPE_Configuration << 8) | (ConfigNumber - 1)), + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(ConfigHeader)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ErrorCode; + + *ConfigSizePtr = le16_to_cpu(DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(ConfigHeader, USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t)->TotalConfigurationSize); + + if (*ConfigSizePtr > BufferSize) + return HOST_GETCONFIG_BuffOverflow; + + USB_ControlRequest.wLength = *ConfigSizePtr; + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(BufferPtr)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ErrorCode; + + if (DESCRIPTOR_TYPE(BufferPtr) != DTYPE_Configuration) + return HOST_GETCONFIG_InvalidData; + + return HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful; +} +#endif + +void USB_GetNextDescriptorOfType(uint16_t* const BytesRem, + void** const CurrConfigLoc, + const uint8_t Type) +{ + while (*BytesRem) + { + USB_GetNextDescriptor(BytesRem, CurrConfigLoc); + + if (DESCRIPTOR_TYPE(*CurrConfigLoc) == Type) + return; + } +} + +void USB_GetNextDescriptorOfTypeBefore(uint16_t* const BytesRem, + void** const CurrConfigLoc, + const uint8_t Type, + const uint8_t BeforeType) +{ + while (*BytesRem) + { + USB_GetNextDescriptor(BytesRem, CurrConfigLoc); + + if (DESCRIPTOR_TYPE(*CurrConfigLoc) == Type) + { + return; + } + else if (DESCRIPTOR_TYPE(*CurrConfigLoc) == BeforeType) + { + *BytesRem = 0; + return; + } + } +} + +void USB_GetNextDescriptorOfTypeAfter(uint16_t* const BytesRem, + void** const CurrConfigLoc, + const uint8_t Type, + const uint8_t AfterType) +{ + USB_GetNextDescriptorOfType(BytesRem, CurrConfigLoc, AfterType); + + if (*BytesRem) + USB_GetNextDescriptorOfType(BytesRem, CurrConfigLoc, Type); +} + +uint8_t USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(uint16_t* const BytesRem, + void** const CurrConfigLoc, + ConfigComparatorPtr_t const ComparatorRoutine) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + while (*BytesRem) + { + uint8_t* PrevDescLoc = *CurrConfigLoc; + uint16_t PrevBytesRem = *BytesRem; + + USB_GetNextDescriptor(BytesRem, CurrConfigLoc); + + if ((ErrorCode = ComparatorRoutine(*CurrConfigLoc)) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound) + { + if (ErrorCode == DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail) + { + *CurrConfigLoc = PrevDescLoc; + *BytesRem = PrevBytesRem; + } + + return ErrorCode; + } + } + + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_EndOfDescriptor; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/ConfigDescriptors.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/ConfigDescriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5355ecfe6d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/ConfigDescriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,287 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Configuration Descriptor definitions. + * \copydetails Group_ConfigDescriptorParser + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_StdDescriptors + * \defgroup Group_ConfigDescriptorParser Configuration Descriptor Parser + * \brief USB Configuration Descriptor definitions. + * + * This section of the library gives a friendly API which can be used in host applications to easily + * parse an attached device's configuration descriptor so that endpoint, interface and other descriptor + * data can be extracted and used as needed. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __CONFIGDESCRIPTORS_H__ +#define __CONFIGDESCRIPTORS_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "USBMode.h" + #include "HostStandardReq.h" + #include "StdDescriptors.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Casts a pointer to a descriptor inside the configuration descriptor into a pointer to the given + * descriptor type. + * + * Usage Example: + * \code + * uint8_t* CurrDescriptor = &ConfigDescriptor[0]; // Pointing to the configuration header + * USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t* ConfigHeaderPtr = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrDescriptor, + * USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t); + * + * // Can now access elements of the configuration header struct using the -> indirection operator + * \endcode + */ + #define DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(DescriptorPtr, Type) ((Type*)(DescriptorPtr)) + + /** Casts a pointer to a descriptor inside the configuration descriptor into the given descriptor + * type (as an actual struct instance rather than a pointer to a struct). + * + * Usage Example: + * \code + * uint8_t* CurrDescriptor = &ConfigDescriptor[0]; // Pointing to the configuration header + * USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t ConfigHeader = DESCRIPTOR_CAST(CurrDescriptor, + * USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t); + * + * // Can now access elements of the configuration header struct using the . operator + * \endcode + */ + #define DESCRIPTOR_CAST(DescriptorPtr, Type) (*DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(DescriptorPtr, Type)) + + /** Returns the descriptor's type, expressed as the 8-bit type value in the header of the descriptor. + * This value's meaning depends on the descriptor's placement in the descriptor, but standard type + * values can be accessed in the \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t enum. + */ + #define DESCRIPTOR_TYPE(DescriptorPtr) DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(DescriptorPtr, USB_Descriptor_Header_t)->Type + + /** Returns the descriptor's size, expressed as the 8-bit value indicating the number of bytes. */ + #define DESCRIPTOR_SIZE(DescriptorPtr) DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(DescriptorPtr, USB_Descriptor_Header_t)->Size + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a Configuration Descriptor comparator function (function taking a pointer to an array + * of type void, returning a uint8_t value). + * + * \see \ref USB_GetNextDescriptorComp function for more details. + */ + typedef uint8_t (* ConfigComparatorPtr_t)(void*); + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor() function. */ + enum USB_Host_GetConfigDescriptor_ErrorCodes_t + { + HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful = 0, /**< No error occurred while retrieving the configuration descriptor. */ + HOST_GETCONFIG_DeviceDisconnect = 1, /**< The attached device was disconnected while retrieving the configuration + * descriptor. + */ + HOST_GETCONFIG_PipeError = 2, /**< An error occurred in the pipe while sending the request. */ + HOST_GETCONFIG_SetupStalled = 3, /**< The attached device stalled the request to retrieve the configuration + * descriptor. + */ + HOST_GETCONFIG_SoftwareTimeOut = 4, /**< The request or data transfer timed out. */ + HOST_GETCONFIG_BuffOverflow = 5, /**< The device's configuration descriptor is too large to fit into the allocated + * buffer. + */ + HOST_GETCONFIG_InvalidData = 6, /**< The device returned invalid configuration descriptor data. */ + }; + + /** Enum for return values of a descriptor comparator function. */ + enum DSearch_Return_ErrorCodes_t + { + DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found = 0, /**< Current descriptor matches comparator criteria. */ + DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail = 1, /**< No further descriptor could possibly match criteria, fail the search. */ + DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound = 2, /**< Current descriptor does not match comparator criteria. */ + }; + + /** Enum for return values of \ref USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(). */ + enum DSearch_Comp_Return_ErrorCodes_t + { + DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found = 0, /**< Configuration descriptor now points to descriptor which matches + * search criteria of the given comparator function. */ + DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Fail = 1, /**< Comparator function returned \ref DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail. */ + DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_EndOfDescriptor = 2, /**< End of configuration descriptor reached before match found. */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Retrieves the configuration descriptor data from an attached device via a standard request into a buffer, + * including validity and size checking to prevent a buffer overflow. + * + * \param[in] ConfigNumber Device configuration descriptor number to fetch from the device (usually set to 1 for + * single configuration devices). + * \param[in,out] ConfigSizePtr Pointer to a location for storing the retrieved configuration descriptor size. + * \param[out] BufferPtr Pointer to the buffer for storing the configuration descriptor data. + * \param[out] BufferSize Size of the allocated buffer where the configuration descriptor is to be stored. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_GetConfigDescriptor_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(const uint8_t ConfigNumber, + uint16_t* const ConfigSizePtr, + void* const BufferPtr, + const uint16_t BufferSize) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /** Skips to the next sub-descriptor inside the configuration descriptor of the specified type value. + * The bytes remaining value is automatically decremented. + * + * \param[in,out] BytesRem Pointer to the number of bytes remaining of the configuration descriptor. + * \param[in,out] CurrConfigLoc Pointer to the current descriptor inside the configuration descriptor. + * \param[in] Type Descriptor type value to search for. + */ + void USB_GetNextDescriptorOfType(uint16_t* const BytesRem, + void** const CurrConfigLoc, + const uint8_t Type) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Skips to the next sub-descriptor inside the configuration descriptor of the specified type value, + * which must come before a descriptor of the second given type value. If the BeforeType type + * descriptor is reached first, the number of bytes remaining to process is set to zero and the + * function exits. The bytes remaining value is automatically decremented. + * + * \param[in,out] BytesRem Pointer to the number of bytes remaining of the configuration descriptor. + * \param[in,out] CurrConfigLoc Pointer to the current descriptor inside the configuration descriptor. + * \param[in] Type Descriptor type value to search for. + * \param[in] BeforeType Descriptor type value which must not be reached before the given Type descriptor. + */ + void USB_GetNextDescriptorOfTypeBefore(uint16_t* const BytesRem, + void** const CurrConfigLoc, + const uint8_t Type, + const uint8_t BeforeType) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Skips to the next sub-descriptor inside the configuration descriptor of the specified type value, + * which must come after a descriptor of the second given type value. The bytes remaining value is + * automatically decremented. + * + * \param[in,out] BytesRem Pointer to the number of bytes remaining of the configuration descriptor. + * \param[in,out] CurrConfigLoc Pointer to the current descriptor inside the configuration descriptor. + * \param[in] Type Descriptor type value to search for. + * \param[in] AfterType Descriptor type value which must be reached before the given Type descriptor. + */ + void USB_GetNextDescriptorOfTypeAfter(uint16_t* const BytesRem, + void** const CurrConfigLoc, + const uint8_t Type, + const uint8_t AfterType) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /** Searches for the next descriptor in the given configuration descriptor using a pre-made comparator + * function. The routine updates the position and remaining configuration descriptor bytes values + * automatically. If a comparator routine fails a search, the descriptor pointer is retreated back + * so that the next descriptor search invocation will start from the descriptor which first caused the + * original search to fail. This behavior allows for one comparator to be used immediately after another + * has failed, starting the second search from the descriptor which failed the first. + * + * Comparator functions should be standard functions which accept a pointer to the header of the current + * descriptor inside the configuration descriptor which is being compared, and should return a value from + * the \ref DSearch_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum as a uint8_t value. + * + * \note This function is available in USB Host mode only. + * + * \param[in,out] BytesRem Pointer to an int storing the remaining bytes in the configuration descriptor. + * \param[in,out] CurrConfigLoc Pointer to the current position in the configuration descriptor. + * \param[in] ComparatorRoutine Name of the comparator search function to use on the configuration descriptor. + * + * \return Value of one of the members of the \ref DSearch_Comp_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum. + * + * Usage Example: + * \code + * uint8_t EndpointSearcher(void* CurrentDescriptor); // Comparator Prototype + * + * uint8_t EndpointSearcher(void* CurrentDescriptor) + * { + * if (DESCRIPTOR_TYPE(CurrentDescriptor) == DTYPE_Endpoint) + * return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + * else + * return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; + * } + * + * //... + * + * // After retrieving configuration descriptor: + * if (USB_Host_GetNextDescriptorComp(&BytesRemaining, &CurrentConfigLoc, EndpointSearcher) == + * Descriptor_Search_Comp_Found) + * { + * // Do something with the endpoint descriptor + * } + * \endcode + */ + uint8_t USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(uint16_t* const BytesRem, + void** const CurrConfigLoc, + ConfigComparatorPtr_t const ComparatorRoutine) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) + ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Skips over the current sub-descriptor inside the configuration descriptor, so that the pointer then + points to the next sub-descriptor. The bytes remaining value is automatically decremented. + * + * \param[in,out] BytesRem Pointer to the number of bytes remaining of the configuration descriptor. + * \param[in,out] CurrConfigLoc Pointer to the current descriptor inside the configuration descriptor. + */ + static inline void USB_GetNextDescriptor(uint16_t* const BytesRem, + void** CurrConfigLoc) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + static inline void USB_GetNextDescriptor(uint16_t* const BytesRem, + void** CurrConfigLoc) + { + uint16_t CurrDescriptorSize = DESCRIPTOR_CAST(*CurrConfigLoc, USB_Descriptor_Header_t).Size; + + if (*BytesRem < CurrDescriptorSize) + CurrDescriptorSize = *BytesRem; + + *CurrConfigLoc = (void*)((uintptr_t)*CurrConfigLoc + CurrDescriptorSize); + *BytesRem -= CurrDescriptorSize; + } + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/Device.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/Device.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..81b0e17028 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/Device.h @@ -0,0 +1,159 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Common USB Device definitions for all architectures. + * \copydetails Group_Device + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USB + * \defgroup Group_Device Device Management + * \brief USB Device management definitions for USB device mode. + * + * USB Device mode related definitions common to all architectures. This module contains definitions which + * are used when the USB controller is initialized in device mode. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __USBDEVICE_H__ +#define __USBDEVICE_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "USBMode.h" + #include "StdDescriptors.h" + #include "USBInterrupt.h" + #include "Endpoint.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the various states of the USB Device state machine. Only some states are + * implemented in the LUFA library - other states are left to the user to implement. + * + * For information on each possible USB device state, refer to the USB 2.0 specification. + * + * \see \ref USB_DeviceState, which stores the current device state machine state. + */ + enum USB_Device_States_t + { + DEVICE_STATE_Unattached = 0, /**< Internally implemented by the library. This state indicates + * that the device is not currently connected to a host. + */ + DEVICE_STATE_Powered = 1, /**< Internally implemented by the library. This state indicates + * that the device is connected to a host, but enumeration has not + * yet begun. + */ + DEVICE_STATE_Default = 2, /**< Internally implemented by the library. This state indicates + * that the device's USB bus has been reset by the host and it is + * now waiting for the host to begin the enumeration process. + */ + DEVICE_STATE_Addressed = 3, /**< Internally implemented by the library. This state indicates + * that the device has been addressed by the USB Host, but is not + * yet configured. + */ + DEVICE_STATE_Configured = 4, /**< May be implemented by the user project. This state indicates + * that the device has been enumerated by the host and is ready + * for USB communications to begin. + */ + DEVICE_STATE_Suspended = 5, /**< May be implemented by the user project. This state indicates + * that the USB bus has been suspended by the host, and the device + * should power down to a minimal power level until the bus is + * resumed. + */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Function to retrieve a given descriptor's size and memory location from the given descriptor type value, + * index and language ID. This function MUST be overridden in the user application (added with full, identical + * prototype and name so that the library can call it to retrieve descriptor data. + * + * \param[in] wValue The type of the descriptor to retrieve in the upper byte, and the index in the + * lower byte (when more than one descriptor of the given type exists, such as the + * case of string descriptors). The type may be one of the standard types defined + * in the DescriptorTypes_t enum, or may be a class-specific descriptor type value. + * \param[in] wIndex The language ID of the string to return if the \c wValue type indicates + * \ref DTYPE_String, otherwise zero for standard descriptors, or as defined in a + * class-specific standards. + * \param[out] DescriptorAddress Pointer to the descriptor in memory. This should be set by the routine to + * the address of the descriptor. + * \param[out] DescriptorMemorySpace A value from the \ref USB_DescriptorMemorySpaces_t enum to indicate the memory + * space in which the descriptor is stored. This parameter does not exist when one + * of the \c USE_*_DESCRIPTORS compile time options is used, or on architectures which + * use a unified address space. + * + * \note By default, the library expects all descriptors to be located in flash memory via the \c PROGMEM attribute. + * If descriptors should be located in RAM or EEPROM instead (to speed up access in the case of RAM, or to + * allow the descriptors to be changed dynamically at runtime) either the \c USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS or the + * \c USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS tokens may be defined in the project makefile and passed to the compiler by the -D + * switch. + * + * \return Size in bytes of the descriptor if it exists, zero or \ref NO_DESCRIPTOR otherwise. + */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress + #if (defined(ARCH_HAS_MULTI_ADDRESS_SPACE) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) && \ + !(defined(USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS) || defined(USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS) || defined(USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS)) + , uint8_t* const DescriptorMemorySpace + #endif + ) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /* Architecture Includes: */ + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + #include "AVR8/Device_AVR8.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + #include "UC3/Device_UC3.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + #include "XMEGA/Device_XMEGA.h" + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/DeviceStandardReq.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/DeviceStandardReq.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..feb092dbf7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/DeviceStandardReq.c @@ -0,0 +1,393 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_DEVICESTDREQ_C +#include "DeviceStandardReq.h" + +uint8_t USB_Device_ConfigurationNumber; + +#if !defined(NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER) +bool USB_Device_CurrentlySelfPowered; +#endif + +#if !defined(NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP) +bool USB_Device_RemoteWakeupEnabled; +#endif + +void USB_Device_ProcessControlRequest(void) +{ + #if defined(ARCH_BIG_ENDIAN) + USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType = Endpoint_Read_8(); + USB_ControlRequest.bRequest = Endpoint_Read_8(); + USB_ControlRequest.wValue = Endpoint_Read_16_LE(); + USB_ControlRequest.wIndex = Endpoint_Read_16_LE(); + USB_ControlRequest.wLength = Endpoint_Read_16_LE(); + #else + uint8_t* RequestHeader = (uint8_t*)&USB_ControlRequest; + + for (uint8_t RequestHeaderByte = 0; RequestHeaderByte < sizeof(USB_Request_Header_t); RequestHeaderByte++) + *(RequestHeader++) = Endpoint_Read_8(); + #endif + + EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(); + + if (Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived()) + { + uint8_t bmRequestType = USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType; + + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case REQ_GetStatus: + if ((bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_DEVICE)) || + (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_ENDPOINT))) + { + USB_Device_GetStatus(); + } + + break; + case REQ_ClearFeature: + case REQ_SetFeature: + if ((bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_DEVICE)) || + (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_ENDPOINT))) + { + USB_Device_ClearSetFeature(); + } + + break; + case REQ_SetAddress: + if (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_DEVICE)) + USB_Device_SetAddress(); + + break; + case REQ_GetDescriptor: + if ((bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_DEVICE)) || + (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_INTERFACE))) + { + USB_Device_GetDescriptor(); + } + + break; + case REQ_GetConfiguration: + if (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_DEVICE)) + USB_Device_GetConfiguration(); + + break; + case REQ_SetConfiguration: + if (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_DEVICE)) + USB_Device_SetConfiguration(); + + break; + + default: + break; + } + } + + if (Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived()) + { + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + Endpoint_StallTransaction(); + } +} + +static void USB_Device_SetAddress(void) +{ + uint8_t DeviceAddress = (USB_ControlRequest.wValue & 0x7F); + + USB_Device_SetDeviceAddress(DeviceAddress); + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())); + + USB_Device_EnableDeviceAddress(DeviceAddress); + + USB_DeviceState = (DeviceAddress) ? DEVICE_STATE_Addressed : DEVICE_STATE_Default; +} + +static void USB_Device_SetConfiguration(void) +{ + #if defined(FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS) + if ((uint8_t)USB_ControlRequest.wValue > FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS) + return; + #else + USB_Descriptor_Device_t* DevDescriptorPtr; + + #if defined(ARCH_HAS_MULTI_ADDRESS_SPACE) + #if defined(USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS) + #define MemoryAddressSpace MEMSPACE_FLASH + #elif defined(USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS) + #define MemoryAddressSpace MEMSPACE_EEPROM + #elif defined(USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS) + #define MemoryAddressSpace MEMSPACE_RAM + #else + uint8_t MemoryAddressSpace; + #endif + #endif + + if (CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor((DTYPE_Device << 8), 0, (void*)&DevDescriptorPtr + #if defined(ARCH_HAS_MULTI_ADDRESS_SPACE) && \ + !(defined(USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS) || defined(USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS) || defined(USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS)) + , &MemoryAddressSpace + #endif + ) == NO_DESCRIPTOR) + { + return; + } + + #if defined(ARCH_HAS_MULTI_ADDRESS_SPACE) + if (MemoryAddressSpace == MEMSPACE_FLASH) + { + if (((uint8_t)USB_ControlRequest.wValue > pgm_read_byte(&DevDescriptorPtr->NumberOfConfigurations))) + return; + } + else if (MemoryAddressSpace == MEMSPACE_EEPROM) + { + if (((uint8_t)USB_ControlRequest.wValue > eeprom_read_byte(&DevDescriptorPtr->NumberOfConfigurations))) + return; + } + else + { + if ((uint8_t)USB_ControlRequest.wValue > DevDescriptorPtr->NumberOfConfigurations) + return; + } + #else + if ((uint8_t)USB_ControlRequest.wValue > DevDescriptorPtr->NumberOfConfigurations) + return; + #endif + #endif + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + USB_Device_ConfigurationNumber = (uint8_t)USB_ControlRequest.wValue; + + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); + + if (USB_Device_ConfigurationNumber) + USB_DeviceState = DEVICE_STATE_Configured; + else + USB_DeviceState = (USB_Device_IsAddressSet()) ? DEVICE_STATE_Configured : DEVICE_STATE_Powered; + + EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(); +} + +static void USB_Device_GetConfiguration(void) +{ + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + Endpoint_Write_8(USB_Device_ConfigurationNumber); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); +} + +#if !defined(NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL) && (USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL != NO_DESCRIPTOR) +static void USB_Device_GetInternalSerialDescriptor(void) +{ + struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; + uint16_t UnicodeString[INTERNAL_SERIAL_LENGTH_BITS / 4]; + } SignatureDescriptor; + + SignatureDescriptor.Header.Type = DTYPE_String; + SignatureDescriptor.Header.Size = USB_STRING_LEN(INTERNAL_SERIAL_LENGTH_BITS / 4); + + USB_Device_GetSerialString(SignatureDescriptor.UnicodeString); + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(&SignatureDescriptor, sizeof(SignatureDescriptor)); + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); +} +#endif + +static void USB_Device_GetDescriptor(void) +{ + const void* DescriptorPointer; + uint16_t DescriptorSize; + + #if defined(ARCH_HAS_MULTI_ADDRESS_SPACE) && \ + !(defined(USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS) || defined(USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS) || defined(USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS)) + uint8_t DescriptorAddressSpace; + #endif + + #if !defined(NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL) && (USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL != NO_DESCRIPTOR) + if (USB_ControlRequest.wValue == ((DTYPE_String << 8) | USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL)) + { + USB_Device_GetInternalSerialDescriptor(); + return; + } + #endif + + if ((DescriptorSize = CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(USB_ControlRequest.wValue, USB_ControlRequest.wIndex, + &DescriptorPointer + #if defined(ARCH_HAS_MULTI_ADDRESS_SPACE) && \ + !(defined(USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS) || defined(USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS) || defined(USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS)) + , &DescriptorAddressSpace + #endif + )) == NO_DESCRIPTOR) + { + return; + } + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + #if defined(USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS) || !defined(ARCH_HAS_MULTI_ADDRESS_SPACE) + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(DescriptorPointer, DescriptorSize); + #elif defined(USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS) + Endpoint_Write_Control_EStream_LE(DescriptorPointer, DescriptorSize); + #elif defined(USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS) + Endpoint_Write_Control_PStream_LE(DescriptorPointer, DescriptorSize); + #else + if (DescriptorAddressSpace == MEMSPACE_FLASH) + Endpoint_Write_Control_PStream_LE(DescriptorPointer, DescriptorSize); + else if (DescriptorAddressSpace == MEMSPACE_EEPROM) + Endpoint_Write_Control_EStream_LE(DescriptorPointer, DescriptorSize); + else + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(DescriptorPointer, DescriptorSize); + #endif + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); +} + +static void USB_Device_GetStatus(void) +{ + uint8_t CurrentStatus = 0; + + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType) + { + case (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_DEVICE): + { + #if !defined(NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER) + if (USB_Device_CurrentlySelfPowered) + CurrentStatus |= FEATURE_SELFPOWERED_ENABLED; + #endif + + #if !defined(NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP) + if (USB_Device_RemoteWakeupEnabled) + CurrentStatus |= FEATURE_REMOTE_WAKEUP_ENABLED; + #endif + break; + } + case (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_ENDPOINT): + { + #if !defined(CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE) + uint8_t EndpointIndex = ((uint8_t)USB_ControlRequest.wIndex & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK); + + if (EndpointIndex >= ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS) + return; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(EndpointIndex); + + CurrentStatus = Endpoint_IsStalled(); + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP); + #endif + + break; + } + default: + return; + } + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + Endpoint_Write_16_LE(CurrentStatus); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); +} + +static void USB_Device_ClearSetFeature(void) +{ + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType & CONTROL_REQTYPE_RECIPIENT) + { + #if !defined(NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP) + case REQREC_DEVICE: + { + if ((uint8_t)USB_ControlRequest.wValue == FEATURE_SEL_DeviceRemoteWakeup) + USB_Device_RemoteWakeupEnabled = (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest == REQ_SetFeature); + else + return; + + break; + } + #endif + #if !defined(CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE) + case REQREC_ENDPOINT: + { + if ((uint8_t)USB_ControlRequest.wValue == FEATURE_SEL_EndpointHalt) + { + uint8_t EndpointIndex = ((uint8_t)USB_ControlRequest.wIndex & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK); + + if (EndpointIndex == ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP || EndpointIndex >= ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS) + return; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(EndpointIndex); + + if (Endpoint_IsEnabled()) + { + if (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest == REQ_SetFeature) + { + Endpoint_StallTransaction(); + } + else + { + Endpoint_ClearStall(); + Endpoint_ResetEndpoint(EndpointIndex); + Endpoint_ResetDataToggle(); + } + } + } + + break; + } + #endif + default: + return; + } + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP); + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(); +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/DeviceStandardReq.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/DeviceStandardReq.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..14badcda1f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/DeviceStandardReq.h @@ -0,0 +1,158 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB device standard request management. + * + * This file contains the function prototypes necessary for the processing of incoming standard control requests + * when the library is in USB device mode. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +#ifndef __DEVICESTDREQ_H__ +#define __DEVICESTDREQ_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "USBMode.h" + #include "StdDescriptors.h" + #include "Events.h" + #include "StdRequestType.h" + #include "USBTask.h" + #include "USBController.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Enums: */ + #if defined(ARCH_HAS_MULTI_ADDRESS_SPACE) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Enum for the possible descriptor memory spaces, for the \c MemoryAddressSpace parameter of the + * \ref CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor() function. This can be used when none of the \c USE_*_DESCRIPTORS + * compile time options are used, to indicate in which memory space the descriptor is stored. + * + * \ingroup Group_Device + */ + enum USB_DescriptorMemorySpaces_t + { + #if defined(ARCH_HAS_FLASH_ADDRESS_SPACE) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + MEMSPACE_FLASH = 0, /**< Indicates the requested descriptor is located in FLASH memory. */ + #endif + #if defined(ARCH_HAS_EEPROM_ADDRESS_SPACE) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + MEMSPACE_EEPROM = 1, /**< Indicates the requested descriptor is located in EEPROM memory. */ + #endif + MEMSPACE_RAM = 2, /**< Indicates the requested descriptor is located in RAM memory. */ + }; + #endif + + /* Global Variables: */ + /** Indicates the currently set configuration number of the device. USB devices may have several + * different configurations which the host can select between; this indicates the currently selected + * value, or 0 if no configuration has been selected. + * + * \attention This variable should be treated as read-only in the user application, and never manually + * changed in value. + * + * \ingroup Group_Device + */ + extern uint8_t USB_Device_ConfigurationNumber; + + #if !defined(NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP) + /** Indicates if the host is currently allowing the device to issue remote wakeup events. If this + * flag is cleared, the device should not issue remote wakeup events to the host. + * + * \attention This variable should be treated as read-only in the user application, and never manually + * changed in value. + * + * \note To reduce FLASH usage of the compiled applications where Remote Wakeup is not supported, + * this global and the underlying management code can be disabled by defining the + * \c NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP token in the project makefile and passing it to the compiler via + * the -D switch. + * + * \ingroup Group_Device + */ + extern bool USB_Device_RemoteWakeupEnabled; + #endif + + #if !defined(NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER) + /** Indicates if the device is currently being powered by its own power supply, rather than being + * powered by the host's USB supply. This flag should remain cleared if the device does not + * support self powered mode, as indicated in the device descriptors. + * + * \ingroup Group_Device + */ + extern bool USB_Device_CurrentlySelfPowered; + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #if defined(USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS) && defined(USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS) + #error USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS and USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS are mutually exclusive. + #elif defined(USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS) && defined(USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS) + #error USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS and USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS are mutually exclusive. + #elif defined(USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS) && defined(USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS) + #error USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS and USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS are mutually exclusive. + #elif defined(USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS) && defined(USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS) && defined(USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS) + #error Only one of the USE_*_DESCRIPTORS modes should be selected. + #endif + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void USB_Device_ProcessControlRequest(void); + + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_DEVICESTDREQ_C) + static void USB_Device_SetAddress(void); + static void USB_Device_SetConfiguration(void); + static void USB_Device_GetConfiguration(void); + static void USB_Device_GetDescriptor(void); + static void USB_Device_GetStatus(void); + static void USB_Device_ClearSetFeature(void); + + #if !defined(NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL) && (USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL != NO_DESCRIPTOR) + static void USB_Device_GetInternalSerialDescriptor(void); + #endif + #endif + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/Endpoint.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/Endpoint.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b577f63476 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/Endpoint.h @@ -0,0 +1,130 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Endpoint definitions for all architectures. + * \copydetails Group_EndpointManagement + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_EndpointManagement + * \defgroup Group_EndpointRW Endpoint Data Reading and Writing + * \brief Endpoint data read/write definitions. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing from and to endpoints. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_EndpointRW + * \defgroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW Read/Write of Primitive Data Types + * \brief Endpoint data primitive read/write definitions. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing of primitive data types + * from and to endpoints. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_EndpointManagement + * \defgroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement Endpoint Packet Management + * \brief USB Endpoint package management definitions. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to packet management of endpoints. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USB + * \defgroup Group_EndpointManagement Endpoint Management + * \brief Endpoint management definitions. + * + * Functions, macros and enums related to endpoint management when in USB Device mode. This + * module contains the endpoint management macros, as well as endpoint interrupt and data + * send/receive functions for various data types. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __ENDPOINT_H__ +#define __ENDPOINT_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "USBMode.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a endpoint table entry, used to configure endpoints in groups via + * \ref Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(). + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Address; /**< Address of the endpoint to configure, or zero if the table entry is to be unused. */ + uint16_t Size; /**< Size of the endpoint bank, in bytes. */ + uint8_t Type; /**< Type of the endpoint, a \c EP_TYPE_* mask. */ + uint8_t Banks; /**< Number of hardware banks to use for the endpoint. */ + } USB_Endpoint_Table_t; + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint number mask, for masking against endpoint addresses to retrieve the endpoint's + * numerical address in the device. + */ + #define ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK 0x0F + + /** Endpoint address for the default control endpoint, which always resides in address 0. This is + * defined for convenience to give more readable code when used with the endpoint macros. + */ + #define ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP 0 + + /* Architecture Includes: */ + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + #include "AVR8/Endpoint_AVR8.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + #include "UC3/Endpoint_UC3.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + #include "XMEGA/Endpoint_XMEGA.h" + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/EndpointStream.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/EndpointStream.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..156d155b3d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/EndpointStream.h @@ -0,0 +1,124 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Endpoint data stream transmission and reception management. + * \copydetails Group_EndpointStreamRW + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_EndpointRW + * \defgroup Group_EndpointStreamRW Read/Write of Multi-Byte Streams + * \brief Endpoint data stream transmission and reception management. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing of data streams from + * and to endpoints. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __ENDPOINT_STREAM_H__ +#define __ENDPOINT_STREAM_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "USBMode.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible error return codes of the \c Endpoint_*_Stream_* functions. */ + enum Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t + { + ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError = 0, /**< Command completed successfully, no error. */ + ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_EndpointStalled = 1, /**< The endpoint was stalled during the stream + * transfer by the host or device. + */ + ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected = 2, /**< Device was disconnected from the host during + * the transfer. + */ + ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_BusSuspended = 3, /**< The USB bus has been suspended by the host and + * no USB endpoint traffic can occur until the bus + * has resumed. + */ + ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_Timeout = 4, /**< The host failed to accept or send the next packet + * within the software timeout period set by the + * \ref USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS macro. + */ + ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer = 5, /**< Indicates that the endpoint bank became full or empty before + * the complete contents of the current stream could be + * transferred. The endpoint stream function should be called + * again to process the next chunk of data in the transfer. + */ + }; + + /** Enum for the possible error return codes of the \c Endpoint_*_Control_Stream_* functions. */ + enum Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t + { + ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_NoError = 0, /**< Command completed successfully, no error. */ + ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_HostAborted = 1, /**< The aborted the transfer prematurely. */ + ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected = 2, /**< Device was disconnected from the host during + * the transfer. + */ + ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_BusSuspended = 3, /**< The USB bus has been suspended by the host and + * no USB endpoint traffic can occur until the bus + * has resumed. + */ + }; + + /* Architecture Includes: */ + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + #include "AVR8/EndpointStream_AVR8.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + #include "UC3/EndpointStream_UC3.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + #include "XMEGA/EndpointStream_XMEGA.h" + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/Events.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/Events.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..186557956a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/Events.c @@ -0,0 +1,39 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_EVENTS_C +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "Events.h" + +void USB_Event_Stub(void) +{ + +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/Events.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/Events.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..57fd0d9af7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/Events.h @@ -0,0 +1,372 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Event management definitions. + * \copydetails Group_Events + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USB + * \defgroup Group_Events USB Events + * \brief USB Event management definitions. + * + * This module contains macros and functions relating to the management of library events, which are small + * pieces of code similar to ISRs which are run when a given condition is met. Each event can be fired from + * multiple places in the user or library code, which may or may not be inside an ISR, thus each handler + * should be written to be as small and fast as possible to prevent possible problems. + * + * Events can be hooked by the user application by declaring a handler function with the same name and parameters + * listed here. If an event with no user-associated handler is fired within the library, it by default maps to an + * internal empty stub function. + * + * Each event must only have one associated event handler, but can be raised by multiple sources by calling the + * event handler function (with any required event parameters). + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __USBEVENTS_H__ +#define __USBEVENTS_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "USBMode.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Pseudo-Functions for Doxygen: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_EVENTS_C) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Event for USB mode pin level change. This event fires when the USB interface is set to dual role + * mode, and the UID pin level has changed to indicate a new mode (device or host). This event fires + * before the mode is switched to the newly indicated mode but after the \ref EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect + * event has fired (if disconnected before the role change). + * + * \note This event only exists on microcontrollers that support dual role USB modes. + * \n\n + * + * \note This event does not exist if the \c USB_DEVICE_ONLY or \c USB_HOST_ONLY tokens have been supplied + * to the compiler (see \ref Group_USBManagement documentation). + */ + void EVENT_USB_UIDChange(void); + + /** Event for USB host error. This event fires when a hardware fault has occurred whilst the USB + * interface is in host mode. + * + * \param[in] ErrorCode Error code indicating the failure reason, a value in \ref USB_Host_ErrorCodes_t. + * + * \note This event only exists on microcontrollers that supports USB host mode. + * \n\n + * + * \note This event does not exist if the \c USB_DEVICE_ONLY token is supplied to the compiler (see + * \ref Group_USBManagement documentation). + */ + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + + /** Event for USB device attachment. This event fires when a the USB interface is in host mode, and + * a USB device has been connected to the USB interface. This is interrupt driven, thus fires before + * the standard \ref EVENT_USB_Device_Connect() event and so can be used to programmatically start the USB + * management task to reduce CPU consumption. + * + * \note This event only exists on microcontrollers that supports USB host mode. + * \n\n + * + * \note This event does not exist if the \c USB_DEVICE_ONLY token is supplied to the compiler (see + * \ref Group_USBManagement documentation). + * + * \see \ref USB_USBTask() for more information on the USB management task and reducing CPU usage. + */ + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + + /** Event for USB device removal. This event fires when a the USB interface is in host mode, and + * a USB device has been removed the USB interface whether or not it has been enumerated. This + * can be used to programmatically stop the USB management task to reduce CPU consumption. + * + * \note This event only exists on microcontrollers that supports USB host mode. + * \n\n + * + * \note This event does not exist if the \c USB_DEVICE_ONLY token is supplied to the compiler (see + * \ref Group_USBManagement documentation). + * + * \see \ref USB_USBTask() for more information on the USB management task and reducing CPU usage. + */ + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + + /** Event for USB device enumeration failure. This event fires when a the USB interface is + * in host mode, and an attached USB device has failed to enumerate completely. + * + * \param[in] ErrorCode Error code indicating the failure reason, a value in + * \ref USB_Host_EnumerationErrorCodes_t. + * + * \param[in] SubErrorCode Sub error code indicating the reason for failure - for example, if the + * ErrorCode parameter indicates a control error, this will give the error + * code returned by the \ref USB_Host_SendControlRequest() function. + * + * \note This event only exists on microcontrollers that supports USB host mode. + * \n\n + * + * \note This event does not exist if the \c USB_DEVICE_ONLY token is supplied to the compiler (see + * \ref Group_USBManagement documentation). + */ + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + + /** Event for USB device enumeration completion. This event fires when a the USB interface is + * in host mode and an attached USB device has been completely enumerated and is ready to be + * controlled by the user application. + * + * This event is time-critical; exceeding OS-specific delays within this event handler (typically of around + * 1 second) when a transaction is waiting to be processed by the device will prevent break communications + * and cause the host to reset the USB bus. + * + * \note This event only exists on microcontrollers that supports USB host mode. + * \n\n + * + * \note This event does not exist if the \c USB_DEVICE_ONLY token is supplied to the compiler (see + * \ref Group_USBManagement documentation). + */ + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + + /** Event for USB Start Of Frame detection, when enabled. This event fires at the start of each USB + * frame, once per millisecond, and is synchronized to the USB bus. This can be used as an accurate + * millisecond timer source when the USB bus is not suspended while in host mode. + * + * This event is time-critical; it is run once per millisecond and thus long handlers will significantly + * degrade device performance. This event should only be enabled when needed to reduce device wake-ups. + * + * \note This event is not normally active - it must be manually enabled and disabled via the + * \ref USB_Host_EnableSOFEvents() and \ref USB_Host_DisableSOFEvents() commands after enumeration of + * a USB device. + * \n\n + * + * \note This event does not exist if the \c USB_DEVICE_ONLY token is supplied to the compiler (see + * \ref Group_USBManagement documentation). + */ + void EVENT_USB_Host_StartOfFrame(void); + + /** Event for USB device connection. This event fires when the microcontroller is in USB Device mode + * and the device is connected to a USB host, beginning the enumeration process measured by a rising + * level on the microcontroller's VBUS sense pin. + * + * This event is time-critical; exceeding OS-specific delays within this event handler (typically of around + * two seconds) will prevent the device from enumerating correctly. + * + * \attention This event may fire multiple times during device enumeration on the microcontrollers with limited USB controllers + * if \c NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT is not defined. + * + * \note For the microcontrollers with limited USB controller functionality, VBUS sensing is not available. + * this means that the current connection state is derived from the bus suspension and wake up events by default, + * which is not always accurate (host may suspend the bus while still connected). If the actual connection state + * needs to be determined, VBUS should be routed to an external pin, and the auto-detect behavior turned off by + * passing the \c NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT token to the compiler via the -D switch at compile time. The connection + * and disconnection events may be manually fired, and the \ref USB_DeviceState global changed manually. + * \n\n + * + * \see \ref Group_USBManagement for more information on the USB management task and reducing CPU usage. + */ + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + + /** Event for USB device disconnection. This event fires when the microcontroller is in USB Device mode and the device is + * disconnected from a host, measured by a falling level on the microcontroller's VBUS sense pin. + * + * \attention This event may fire multiple times during device enumeration on the microcontrollers with limited USB controllers + * if \c NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT is not defined. + * + * \note For the microcontrollers with limited USB controllers, VBUS sense is not available to the USB controller. + * this means that the current connection state is derived from the bus suspension and wake up events by default, + * which is not always accurate (host may suspend the bus while still connected). If the actual connection state + * needs to be determined, VBUS should be routed to an external pin, and the auto-detect behavior turned off by + * passing the \c NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT token to the compiler via the -D switch at compile time. The connection + * and disconnection events may be manually fired, and the \ref USB_DeviceState global changed manually. + * \n\n + * + * \see \ref Group_USBManagement for more information on the USB management task and reducing CPU usage. + */ + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + + /** Event for control requests. This event fires when a the USB host issues a control request + * to the mandatory device control endpoint (of address 0). This may either be a standard + * request that the library may have a handler code for internally, or a class specific request + * issued to the device which must be handled appropriately. If a request is not processed in the + * user application via this event, it will be passed to the library for processing internally + * if a suitable handler exists. + * + * This event is time-critical; each packet within the request transaction must be acknowledged or + * sent within 50ms or the host will abort the transfer. + * + * The library internally handles all standard control requests with the exceptions of SYNC FRAME, + * SET DESCRIPTOR and SET INTERFACE. These and all other non-standard control requests will be left + * for the user to process via this event if desired. If not handled in the user application or by + * the library internally, unknown requests are automatically STALLed. + * + * \note This event does not exist if the \c USB_HOST_ONLY token is supplied to the compiler (see + * \ref Group_USBManagement documentation). + * \n\n + * + * \note Requests should be handled in the same manner as described in the USB 2.0 Specification, + * or appropriate class specification. In all instances, the library has already read the + * request SETUP parameters into the \ref USB_ControlRequest structure which should then be used + * by the application to determine how to handle the issued request. + */ + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + + /** Event for USB configuration number changed. This event fires when a the USB host changes the + * selected configuration number while in device mode. This event should be hooked in device + * applications to create the endpoints and configure the device for the selected configuration. + * + * This event is time-critical; exceeding OS-specific delays within this event handler (typically of around + * one second) will prevent the device from enumerating correctly. + * + * This event fires after the value of \ref USB_Device_ConfigurationNumber has been changed. + * + * \note This event does not exist if the \c USB_HOST_ONLY token is supplied to the compiler (see + * \ref Group_USBManagement documentation). + */ + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + + /** Event for USB suspend. This event fires when a the USB host suspends the device by halting its + * transmission of Start Of Frame pulses to the device. This is generally hooked in order to move + * the device over to a low power state until the host wakes up the device. If the USB interface is + * enumerated with the \ref USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL option set, the library will automatically suspend the + * USB PLL before the event is fired to save power. + * + * \note This event does not exist if the \c USB_HOST_ONLY token is supplied to the compiler (see + * \ref Group_USBManagement documentation). + * \n\n + * + * \note This event does not exist on the microcontrollers with limited USB VBUS sensing abilities + * when the \c NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT compile time token is not set - see + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect. + * + * \see \ref EVENT_USB_Device_WakeUp() event for accompanying Wake Up event. + */ + void EVENT_USB_Device_Suspend(void); + + /** Event for USB wake up. This event fires when a the USB interface is suspended while in device + * mode, and the host wakes up the device by supplying Start Of Frame pulses. This is generally + * hooked to pull the user application out of a low power state and back into normal operating + * mode. If the USB interface is enumerated with the \ref USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL option set, the library + * will automatically restart the USB PLL before the event is fired. + * + * \note This event does not exist if the \c USB_HOST_ONLY token is supplied to the compiler (see + * \ref Group_USBManagement documentation). + * \n\n + * + * \note This event does not exist on the microcontrollers with limited USB VBUS sensing abilities + * when the \c NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT compile time token is not set - see + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect. + * + * \see \ref EVENT_USB_Device_Suspend() event for accompanying Suspend event. + */ + void EVENT_USB_Device_WakeUp(void); + + /** Event for USB interface reset. This event fires when the USB interface is in device mode, and + * a the USB host requests that the device reset its interface. This event fires after the control + * endpoint has been automatically configured by the library. + * + * This event is time-critical; exceeding OS-specific delays within this event handler (typically of around + * two seconds) will prevent the device from enumerating correctly. + * + * \note This event does not exist if the \c USB_HOST_ONLY token is supplied to the compiler (see + * \ref Group_USBManagement documentation). + */ + void EVENT_USB_Device_Reset(void); + + /** Event for USB Start Of Frame detection, when enabled. This event fires at the start of each USB + * frame, once per millisecond, and is synchronized to the USB bus. This can be used as an accurate + * millisecond timer source when the USB bus is enumerated in device mode to a USB host. + * + * This event is time-critical; it is run once per millisecond and thus long handlers will significantly + * degrade device performance. This event should only be enabled when needed to reduce device wake-ups. + * + * \pre This event is not normally active - it must be manually enabled and disabled via the + * \ref USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents() and \ref USB_Device_DisableSOFEvents() commands after enumeration. + * \n\n + * + * \note This event does not exist if the \c USB_HOST_ONLY token is supplied to the compiler (see + * \ref Group_USBManagement documentation). + */ + void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void); + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_EVENTS_C) + void USB_Event_Stub(void) ATTR_CONST; + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + void EVENT_USB_UIDChange(void) ATTR_WEAK ATTR_ALIAS(USB_Event_Stub); + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) ATTR_WEAK ATTR_ALIAS(USB_Event_Stub); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) ATTR_WEAK ATTR_ALIAS(USB_Event_Stub); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) ATTR_WEAK ATTR_ALIAS(USB_Event_Stub); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) ATTR_WEAK ATTR_ALIAS(USB_Event_Stub); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) + ATTR_WEAK ATTR_ALIAS(USB_Event_Stub); + void EVENT_USB_Host_StartOfFrame(void) ATTR_WEAK ATTR_ALIAS(USB_Event_Stub); + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) ATTR_WEAK ATTR_ALIAS(USB_Event_Stub); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) ATTR_WEAK ATTR_ALIAS(USB_Event_Stub); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) ATTR_WEAK ATTR_ALIAS(USB_Event_Stub); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) ATTR_WEAK ATTR_ALIAS(USB_Event_Stub); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Suspend(void) ATTR_WEAK ATTR_ALIAS(USB_Event_Stub); + void EVENT_USB_Device_WakeUp(void) ATTR_WEAK ATTR_ALIAS(USB_Event_Stub); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Reset(void) ATTR_WEAK ATTR_ALIAS(USB_Event_Stub); + void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void) ATTR_WEAK ATTR_ALIAS(USB_Event_Stub); + #endif + #endif + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/Host.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/Host.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..50410b2be8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/Host.h @@ -0,0 +1,139 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Common USB Host definitions for all architectures. + * \copydetails Group_Host + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USB + * \defgroup Group_Host Host Management + * \brief USB Host management definitions for USB host mode. + * + * USB Host mode related macros and enums. This module contains macros and enums which are used when + * the USB controller is initialized in host mode. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __USBHOST_H__ +#define __USBHOST_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "USBMode.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the various states of the USB Host state machine. + * + * For information on each possible USB host state, refer to the USB 2.0 specification. + * Several of the USB host states are broken up further into multiple smaller sub-states, + * so that they can be internally implemented inside the library in an efficient manner. + * + * \see \ref USB_HostState, which stores the current host state machine state. + */ + enum USB_Host_States_t + { + HOST_STATE_WaitForDevice = 0, /**< This state indicates that the stack is waiting for an interval + * to elapse before continuing with the next step of the device + * enumeration process. + */ + HOST_STATE_Unattached = 1, /**< This state indicates that the host state machine is waiting for + * a device to be attached so that it can start the enumeration process. + */ + HOST_STATE_Powered = 2, /**< This state indicates that a device has been attached, and the + * library's internals are being configured to begin the enumeration + * process. + */ + HOST_STATE_Powered_WaitForDeviceSettle = 3, /**< This state indicates that the stack is waiting for the initial + * settling period to elapse before beginning the enumeration process. + */ + HOST_STATE_Powered_WaitForConnect = 4, /**< This state indicates that the stack is waiting for a connection event + * from the USB controller to indicate a valid USB device has been attached + * to the bus and is ready to be enumerated. + */ + HOST_STATE_Powered_DoReset = 5, /**< This state indicates that a valid USB device has been attached, and that + * it will now be reset to ensure it is ready for enumeration. + */ + HOST_STATE_Powered_ConfigPipe = 6, /**< This state indicates that the attached device is currently powered and + * reset, and that the control pipe is now being configured by the stack. + */ + HOST_STATE_Default = 7, /**< This state indicates that the stack is currently retrieving the control + * endpoint's size from the device, so that the control pipe can be altered + * to match. + */ + HOST_STATE_Default_PostReset = 8, /**< This state indicates that the control pipe is being reconfigured to match + * the retrieved control endpoint size from the device, and the device's USB + * bus address is being set. + */ + HOST_STATE_Default_PostAddressSet = 9, /**< This state indicates that the device's address has now been set, and the + * stack is has now completed the device enumeration process. This state causes + * the stack to change the current USB device address to that set for the + * connected device, before progressing to the \ref HOST_STATE_Addressed state + * ready for use in the user application. + */ + HOST_STATE_Addressed = 10, /**< Indicates that the device has been enumerated and addressed, and is now waiting + * for the user application to configure the device ready for use. + */ + HOST_STATE_Configured = 11, /**< Indicates that the device has been configured into a valid device configuration, + * ready for general use by the user application. + */ + }; + + /* Architecture Includes: */ + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + #include "AVR8/Host_AVR8.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + #include "UC3/Host_UC3.h" + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/HostStandardReq.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/HostStandardReq.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..42a934daa0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/HostStandardReq.c @@ -0,0 +1,322 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_HOSTSTDREQ_C +#include "HostStandardReq.h" + +uint8_t USB_Host_ConfigurationNumber; + +static uint8_t USB_Host_SendControlRequest_PRV(void* const BufferPtr) +{ + uint8_t* DataStream = (uint8_t*)BufferPtr; + uint8_t ReturnStatus = HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; + uint16_t DataLen = USB_ControlRequest.wLength; + + USB_Host_ResumeBus(); + + if ((ReturnStatus = USB_Host_WaitMS(1)) != HOST_WAITERROR_Successful) + return ReturnStatus; + + Pipe_SetPipeToken(PIPE_TOKEN_SETUP); + Pipe_ClearError(); + + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + #if defined(ARCH_BIG_ENDIAN) + Pipe_Write_8(USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType); + Pipe_Write_8(USB_ControlRequest.bRequest); + Pipe_Write_16_LE(USB_ControlRequest.wValue); + Pipe_Write_16_LE(USB_ControlRequest.wIndex); + Pipe_Write_16_LE(USB_ControlRequest.wLength); + #else + uint8_t* HeaderStream = (uint8_t*)&USB_ControlRequest; + + for (uint8_t HeaderByte = 0; HeaderByte < sizeof(USB_Request_Header_t); HeaderByte++) + Pipe_Write_8(*(HeaderStream++)); + #endif + + Pipe_ClearSETUP(); + + if ((ReturnStatus = USB_Host_WaitForIOS(USB_HOST_WAITFOR_SetupSent)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ReturnStatus; + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + if ((ReturnStatus = USB_Host_WaitMS(1)) != HOST_WAITERROR_Successful) + return ReturnStatus; + + if ((USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType & CONTROL_REQTYPE_DIRECTION) == REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST) + { + Pipe_SetPipeToken(PIPE_TOKEN_IN); + + if (DataStream != NULL) + { + while (DataLen) + { + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if ((ReturnStatus = USB_Host_WaitForIOS(USB_HOST_WAITFOR_InReceived)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ReturnStatus; + + if (!(Pipe_BytesInPipe())) + DataLen = 0; + + while (Pipe_BytesInPipe() && DataLen) + { + *(DataStream++) = Pipe_Read_8(); + DataLen--; + } + + Pipe_Freeze(); + Pipe_ClearIN(); + } + } + + Pipe_SetPipeToken(PIPE_TOKEN_OUT); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if ((ReturnStatus = USB_Host_WaitForIOS(USB_HOST_WAITFOR_OutReady)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ReturnStatus; + + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + if ((ReturnStatus = USB_Host_WaitForIOS(USB_HOST_WAITFOR_OutReady)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ReturnStatus; + } + else + { + if (DataStream != NULL) + { + Pipe_SetPipeToken(PIPE_TOKEN_OUT); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + while (DataLen) + { + if ((ReturnStatus = USB_Host_WaitForIOS(USB_HOST_WAITFOR_OutReady)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ReturnStatus; + + while (DataLen && (Pipe_BytesInPipe() < USB_Host_ControlPipeSize)) + { + Pipe_Write_8(*(DataStream++)); + DataLen--; + } + + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + } + + if ((ReturnStatus = USB_Host_WaitForIOS(USB_HOST_WAITFOR_OutReady)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ReturnStatus; + + Pipe_Freeze(); + } + + Pipe_SetPipeToken(PIPE_TOKEN_IN); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + if ((ReturnStatus = USB_Host_WaitForIOS(USB_HOST_WAITFOR_InReceived)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + return ReturnStatus; + + Pipe_ClearIN(); + } + + return ReturnStatus; +} + +static uint8_t USB_Host_WaitForIOS(const uint8_t WaitType) +{ + #if (USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS < 0xFF) + uint8_t TimeoutCounter = USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS; + #else + uint16_t TimeoutCounter = USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS; + #endif + + while (!(((WaitType == USB_HOST_WAITFOR_SetupSent) && Pipe_IsSETUPSent()) || + ((WaitType == USB_HOST_WAITFOR_InReceived) && Pipe_IsINReceived()) || + ((WaitType == USB_HOST_WAITFOR_OutReady) && Pipe_IsOUTReady()))) + { + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_WaitMS(1)) != HOST_WAITERROR_Successful) + return ErrorCode; + + if (!(TimeoutCounter--)) + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_SoftwareTimeOut; + } + + return HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful; +} + +uint8_t USB_Host_SendControlRequest(void* const BufferPtr) +{ + bool BusSuspended = USB_Host_IsBusSuspended(); + uint8_t ReturnStatus = USB_Host_SendControlRequest_PRV(BufferPtr); + + Pipe_Freeze(); + + if (BusSuspended) + USB_Host_SuspendBus(); + + Pipe_ResetPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return ReturnStatus; +} + +uint8_t USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(const uint8_t ConfigNumber) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_DEVICE), + .bRequest = REQ_SetConfiguration, + .wValue = ConfigNumber, + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + if ((ErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(NULL)) == HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + USB_Host_ConfigurationNumber = ConfigNumber; + USB_HostState = (ConfigNumber) ? HOST_STATE_Configured : HOST_STATE_Addressed; + } + + return ErrorCode; +} + +uint8_t USB_Host_GetDeviceConfiguration(uint8_t* const ConfigNumber) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_DEVICE), + .bRequest = REQ_GetConfiguration, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = sizeof(uint8_t), + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(ConfigNumber); +} + +uint8_t USB_Host_GetDescriptor(const uint8_t Type, + const uint8_t Index, + void* const Buffer, + const uint8_t BufferLength) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_DEVICE), + .bRequest = REQ_GetDescriptor, + .wValue = (((uint16_t)Type << 8) | Index), + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = BufferLength, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(Buffer); +} + +uint8_t USB_Host_GetDeviceStatus(uint8_t* const FeatureStatus) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_DEVICE), + .bRequest = REQ_GetStatus, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(FeatureStatus); +} + +uint8_t USB_Host_ClearEndpointStall(const uint8_t EndpointAddress) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_ENDPOINT), + .bRequest = REQ_ClearFeature, + .wValue = FEATURE_SEL_EndpointHalt, + .wIndex = EndpointAddress, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(NULL); +} + +uint8_t USB_Host_SetInterfaceAltSetting(const uint8_t InterfaceIndex, + const uint8_t AltSetting) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = REQ_SetInterface, + .wValue = AltSetting, + .wIndex = InterfaceIndex, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(NULL); +} + +uint8_t USB_Host_GetInterfaceAltSetting(const uint8_t InterfaceIndex, + uint8_t* const AltSetting) +{ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = REQ_GetInterface, + .wValue = 0, + .wIndex = InterfaceIndex, + .wLength = sizeof(uint8_t), + }; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + return USB_Host_SendControlRequest(AltSetting); +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/HostStandardReq.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/HostStandardReq.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..66542690ab --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/HostStandardReq.h @@ -0,0 +1,292 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB host standard request management. + * + * This file contains the function prototypes necessary for the issuing of outgoing standard control requests + * when the library is in USB host mode. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +#ifndef __HOSTSTDREQ_H__ +#define __HOSTSTDREQ_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "USBMode.h" + #include "StdRequestType.h" + #include "USBController.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + #if !defined(USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Constant for the maximum software timeout period of sent USB control transactions to an attached + * device. If a device fails to respond to a sent control request within this period, the + * library will return a timeout error code. + * + * This value may be overridden in the user project makefile as the value of the + * \ref USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS token, and passed to the compiler using the -D switch. + */ + #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS 1000 + #endif + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the \ref USB_Host_SendControlRequest() return code, indicating the reason for the error + * if the transfer of the request is unsuccessful. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipeControlReq + */ + enum USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t + { + HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful = 0, /**< No error occurred in the request transfer. */ + HOST_SENDCONTROL_DeviceDisconnected = 1, /**< The attached device was disconnected during the + * request transfer. + */ + HOST_SENDCONTROL_PipeError = 2, /**< An error occurred in the pipe while sending the request. */ + HOST_SENDCONTROL_SetupStalled = 3, /**< The attached device stalled the request, usually + * indicating that the request is unsupported on the device. + */ + HOST_SENDCONTROL_SoftwareTimeOut = 4, /**< The request or data transfer timed out. */ + }; + + /* Global Variables: */ + /** Indicates the currently set configuration number of the attached device. This indicates the currently + * selected configuration value if one has been set successfully, or 0 if no configuration has been selected. + * + * To set a device configuration, call the \ref USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration() function. + * + * \attention This variable should be treated as read-only in the user application, and never manually + * changed in value. + * + * \ingroup Group_Host + */ + extern uint8_t USB_Host_ConfigurationNumber; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Sends the request stored in the \ref USB_ControlRequest global structure to the attached device, + * and transfers the data stored in the buffer to the device, or from the device to the buffer + * as requested. The transfer is made on the currently selected pipe. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipeControlReq + * + * \param[in] BufferPtr Pointer to the start of the data buffer if the request has a data stage, or + * \c NULL if the request transfers no data to or from the device. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum to indicate the result. + */ + uint8_t USB_Host_SendControlRequest(void* const BufferPtr); + + /** Sends a SET CONFIGURATION standard request to the attached device, with the given configuration index. + * + * This routine will automatically update the \ref USB_HostState and \ref USB_Host_ConfigurationNumber + * state variables according to the given function parameters and the result of the request. + * + * \note After this routine returns, the control pipe will be selected. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipeControlReq + * + * \param[in] ConfigNumber Configuration index to send to the device. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum to indicate the result. + */ + uint8_t USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(const uint8_t ConfigNumber); + + /** Sends a GET CONFIGURATION standard request to the attached device, to retrieve the currently selected + * device configuration index. + * + * \note After this routine returns, the control pipe will be selected. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipeControlReq + * + * \param[out] ConfigNumber Pointer to a location where the retrieved configuration index should be stored. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum to indicate the result. + */ + uint8_t USB_Host_GetDeviceConfiguration(uint8_t* const ConfigNumber) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Sends a GET DESCRIPTOR standard request to the attached device, requesting the descriptor of the + * specified type and index. + * + * \note After this routine returns, the control pipe will be selected. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipeControlReq + * + * \param[in] Type Type of descriptor to retrieve, a value from the \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t enum. + * \param[in] Index Index of the descriptor to retrieve. + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination buffer where the retrieved string descriptor is to be stored. + * \param[in] BufferLength Maximum size of the string descriptor which can be stored into the buffer. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum to indicate the result. + */ + uint8_t USB_Host_GetDescriptor(const uint8_t Type, + const uint8_t Index, + void* const Buffer, + const uint8_t BufferLength) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + + /** Retrieves the current feature status of the attached device, via a GET STATUS standard request. The + * retrieved feature status can then be examined by masking the retrieved value with the various + * \c FEATURE_* masks for bus/self power information and remote wakeup support. + * + * \note After this routine returns, the control pipe will be selected. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipeControlReq + * + * \param[out] FeatureStatus Location where the retrieved feature status should be stored. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum to indicate the result. + */ + uint8_t USB_Host_GetDeviceStatus(uint8_t* const FeatureStatus) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Clears a stall condition on the given pipe, via a CLEAR FEATURE standard request to the attached device. + * + * \note After this routine returns, the control pipe will be selected. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipeControlReq + * + * \param[in] EndpointAddress Address of the endpoint to clear, including the endpoint's direction. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum to indicate the result. + */ + uint8_t USB_Host_ClearEndpointStall(const uint8_t EndpointAddress); + + /** Selects a given alternative setting for the specified interface, via a SET INTERFACE standard request to + * the attached device. + * + * \note After this routine returns, the control pipe will be selected. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipeControlReq + * + * \param[in] InterfaceIndex Index of the interface whose alternative setting is to be altered. + * \param[in] AltSetting Index of the interface's alternative setting which is to be selected. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum to indicate the result. + */ + uint8_t USB_Host_SetInterfaceAltSetting(const uint8_t InterfaceIndex, + const uint8_t AltSetting); + + + /** Retrieves the current alternative setting for the specified interface, via a GET INTERFACE standard request to + * the attached device. + * + * \note After this routine returns, the control pipe will be selected. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipeControlReq + * + * \param[in] InterfaceIndex Index of the interface whose alternative setting is to be altered. + * \param[out] AltSetting Pointer to a location where the retrieved alternative setting value should be stored. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum to indicate the result. + */ + uint8_t USB_Host_GetInterfaceAltSetting(const uint8_t InterfaceIndex, + uint8_t* const AltSetting) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Sends a GET DESCRIPTOR standard request to the attached device, requesting the device descriptor. + * This can be used to easily retrieve information about the device such as its VID, PID and power + * requirements. This is a convenience wrapper for \ref USB_Host_GetDescriptor(). + * + * \note After this routine returns, the control pipe will be selected. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipeControlReq + * + * \param[out] DeviceDescriptorPtr Pointer to the destination device descriptor structure where + * the read data is to be stored. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum to indicate the result. + */ + static inline uint8_t USB_Host_GetDeviceDescriptor(USB_Descriptor_Device_t* const DeviceDescriptorPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline uint8_t USB_Host_GetDeviceDescriptor(USB_Descriptor_Device_t* const DeviceDescriptorPtr) + { + return USB_Host_GetDescriptor(DTYPE_Device, 0, DeviceDescriptorPtr, sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t)); + } + + /** Sends a GET DESCRIPTOR standard request to the attached device, requesting the string descriptor + * of the specified index. This can be used to easily retrieve string descriptors from the device by + * index, after the index is obtained from the Device or Configuration descriptors. This is a convenience + * wrapper for \ref USB_Host_GetDescriptor(). + * + * \note After this routine returns, the control pipe will be selected. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipeControlReq + * + * \param[in] Index Index of the string descriptor to retrieve. + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination buffer where the retrieved string descriptor is + * to be stored. + * \param[in] BufferLength Maximum size of the string descriptor which can be stored into the buffer. + * + * \return A value from the \ref USB_Host_SendControlErrorCodes_t enum to indicate the result. + */ + static inline uint8_t USB_Host_GetDeviceStringDescriptor(const uint8_t Index, + void* const Buffer, + const uint8_t BufferLength) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(2); + static inline uint8_t USB_Host_GetDeviceStringDescriptor(const uint8_t Index, + void* const Buffer, + const uint8_t BufferLength) + { + return USB_Host_GetDescriptor(DTYPE_String, Index, Buffer, BufferLength); + } + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Enums: */ + enum USB_WaitForTypes_t + { + USB_HOST_WAITFOR_SetupSent, + USB_HOST_WAITFOR_InReceived, + USB_HOST_WAITFOR_OutReady, + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_HOSTSTDREQ_C) + static uint8_t USB_Host_SendControlRequest_PRV(void* const BufferPtr); + static uint8_t USB_Host_WaitForIOS(const uint8_t WaitType); + #endif + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/OTG.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/OTG.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6293e4cacd --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/OTG.h @@ -0,0 +1,80 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Common USB OTG definitions for all architectures. + * \copydetails Group_OTG + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USB + * \defgroup Group_OTG USB On The Go (OTG) Management + * \brief USB OTG management definitions. + * + * This module contains macros for embedded USB hosts with dual role On The Go capabilities, for managing role + * exchange. OTG is a way for two USB dual role devices to talk to one another directly without fixed device/host + * roles. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __USBOTG_H__ +#define __USBOTG_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "USBMode.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Architecture Includes: */ + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + #include "AVR8/OTG_AVR8.h" + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/Pipe.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/Pipe.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0697078d01 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/Pipe.h @@ -0,0 +1,144 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Common USB Pipe definitions for all architectures. + * \copydetails Group_PipeManagement + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PipeManagement + * \defgroup Group_PipeRW Pipe Data Reading and Writing + * \brief Pipe data read/write definitions. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing from and to pipes. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PipeRW + * \defgroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW Read/Write of Primitive Data Types + * \brief Pipe data primitive read/write definitions. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing of primitive data types + * from and to pipes. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PipeManagement + * \defgroup Group_PipePacketManagement Pipe Packet Management + * \brief Pipe packet management definitions. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to packet management of pipes. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PipeManagement + * \defgroup Group_PipeControlReq Pipe Control Request Management + * \brief Pipe control request definitions. + * + * Module for host mode request processing. This module allows for the transmission of standard, class and + * vendor control requests to the default control endpoint of an attached device while in host mode. + * + * \see Chapter 9 of the USB 2.0 specification. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USB + * \defgroup Group_PipeManagement Pipe Management + * \brief Pipe management definitions. + * + * This module contains functions, macros and enums related to pipe management when in USB Host mode. This + * module contains the pipe management macros, as well as pipe interrupt and data send/receive functions + * for various data types. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __PIPE_H__ +#define __PIPE_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "USBMode.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a pipe table entry, used to configure pipes in groups via + * \ref Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(). + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Address; /**< Address of the pipe to configure, or zero if the table entry is to be unused. */ + uint16_t Size; /**< Size of the pipe bank, in bytes. */ + uint8_t EndpointAddress; /**< Address of the endpoint in the connected device. */ + uint8_t Type; /**< Type of the endpoint, a \c EP_TYPE_* mask. */ + uint8_t Banks; /**< Number of hardware banks to use for the pipe. */ + } USB_Pipe_Table_t; + + /* Macros: */ + /** Pipe address for the default control pipe, which always resides in address 0. This is + * defined for convenience to give more readable code when used with the pipe macros. + */ + #define PIPE_CONTROLPIPE 0 + + /** Pipe number mask, for masking against pipe addresses to retrieve the pipe's numerical address + * in the device. + */ + #define PIPE_PIPENUM_MASK 0x0F + + /** Endpoint number mask, for masking against endpoint addresses to retrieve the endpoint's + * numerical address in the attached device. + */ + #define PIPE_EPNUM_MASK 0x0F + + /* Architecture Includes: */ + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + #include "AVR8/Pipe_AVR8.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + #include "UC3/Pipe_UC3.h" + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/PipeStream.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/PipeStream.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8785302847 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/PipeStream.h @@ -0,0 +1,100 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Pipe data stream transmission and reception management. + * \copydetails Group_PipeStreamRW + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PipeRW + * \defgroup Group_PipeStreamRW Read/Write of Multi-Byte Streams + * \brief Pipe data stream transmission and reception management. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing of data streams from + * and to pipes. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __PIPE_STREAM_H__ +#define __PIPE_STREAM_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "USBMode.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible error return codes of the Pipe_*_Stream_* functions. */ + enum Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t + { + PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError = 0, /**< Command completed successfully, no error. */ + PIPE_RWSTREAM_PipeStalled = 1, /**< The device stalled the pipe during the transfer. */ + PIPE_RWSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected = 2, /**< Device was disconnected from the host during + * the transfer. + */ + PIPE_RWSTREAM_Timeout = 3, /**< The device failed to accept or send the next packet + * within the software timeout period set by the + * \ref USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS macro. + */ + PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer = 4, /**< Indicates that the pipe bank became full/empty before the + * complete contents of the stream could be transferred. + */ + }; + + /* Architecture Includes: */ + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + #include "AVR8/PipeStream_AVR8.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + #include "UC3/PipeStream_UC3.h" + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/StdDescriptors.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/StdDescriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..381c02c53f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/StdDescriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,765 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Common standard USB Descriptor definitions for all architectures. + * \copydetails Group_StdDescriptors + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USB + * \defgroup Group_StdDescriptors USB Descriptors + * \brief Standard USB Descriptor definitions. + * + * Standard USB device descriptor defines and retrieval routines, for USB devices. This module contains + * structures and macros for the easy creation of standard USB descriptors in USB device projects. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __USBDESCRIPTORS_H__ +#define __USBDESCRIPTORS_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "USBMode.h" + #include "Events.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates that a given descriptor does not exist in the device. This can be used inside descriptors + * for string descriptor indexes, or may be use as a return value for GetDescriptor when the specified + * descriptor does not exist. + */ + #define NO_DESCRIPTOR 0 + + /** Macro to calculate the power value for the configuration descriptor, from a given number of milliamperes. + * + * \param[in] mA Maximum number of milliamps the device consumes when the given configuration is selected. + */ + #define USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(mA) ((mA) >> 1) + + /** Macro to calculate the Unicode length of a string with a given number of Unicode characters. + * Should be used in string descriptor's headers for giving the string descriptor's byte length. + * + * \param[in] UnicodeChars Number of Unicode characters in the string text. + */ + #define USB_STRING_LEN(UnicodeChars) (sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Header_t) + ((UnicodeChars) << 1)) + + /** Convenience macro to easily create \ref USB_Descriptor_String_t instances from a wide character string. + * + * \note This macro is for little-endian systems only. + * + * \param[in] String String to initialize a USB String Descriptor structure with. + */ + #define USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(String) { .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Header_t) + (sizeof(String) - 2), .Type = DTYPE_String}, .UnicodeString = String } + + /** Convenience macro to easily create \ref USB_Descriptor_String_t instances from an array of characters. + * + * \param[in] ... Characters to initialize a USB String Descriptor structure with. + */ + #define USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(...) { .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Header_t) + sizeof((uint16_t){__VA_ARGS__}), .Type = DTYPE_String}, .UnicodeString = {__VA_ARGS__} } + + /** Macro to encode a given major/minor/revision version number into Binary Coded Decimal format for descriptor + * fields requiring BCD encoding, such as the USB version number in the standard device descriptor. + * + * \note This value is automatically converted into Little Endian, suitable for direct use inside device + * descriptors on all architectures without endianness conversion macros. + * + * \param[in] Major Major version number to encode. + * \param[in] Minor Minor version number to encode. + * \param[in] Revision Revision version number to encode. + */ + #define VERSION_BCD(Major, Minor, Revision) \ + CPU_TO_LE16( ((Major & 0xFF) << 8) | \ + ((Minor & 0x0F) << 4) | \ + (Revision & 0x0F) ) + + /** String language ID for the English language. Should be used in \ref USB_Descriptor_String_t descriptors + * to indicate that the English language is supported by the device in its string descriptors. + */ + #define LANGUAGE_ID_ENG 0x0409 + + /** \name USB Configuration Descriptor Attribute Masks */ + //@{ + /** Mask for the reserved bit in the Configuration Descriptor's \c ConfigAttributes field, which must be set on all + * devices for historical purposes. + */ + #define USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED 0x80 + + /** Can be masked with other configuration descriptor attributes for a \ref USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t + * descriptor's \c ConfigAttributes value to indicate that the specified configuration can draw its power + * from the device's own power source. + */ + #define USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED 0x40 + + /** Can be masked with other configuration descriptor attributes for a \ref USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t + * descriptor's \c ConfigAttributes value to indicate that the specified configuration supports the + * remote wakeup feature of the USB standard, allowing a suspended USB device to wake up the host upon + * request. + */ + #define USB_CONFIG_ATTR_REMOTEWAKEUP 0x20 + //@} + + /** \name Endpoint Descriptor Attribute Masks */ + //@{ + /** Can be masked with other endpoint descriptor attributes for a \ref USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t descriptor's + * \c Attributes value to indicate that the specified endpoint is not synchronized. + * + * \see The USB specification for more details on the possible Endpoint attributes. + */ + #define ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC (0 << 2) + + /** Can be masked with other endpoint descriptor attributes for a \ref USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t descriptor's + * \c Attributes value to indicate that the specified endpoint is asynchronous. + * + * \see The USB specification for more details on the possible Endpoint attributes. + */ + #define ENDPOINT_ATTR_ASYNC (1 << 2) + + /** Can be masked with other endpoint descriptor attributes for a \ref USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t descriptor's + * \c Attributes value to indicate that the specified endpoint is adaptive. + * + * \see The USB specification for more details on the possible Endpoint attributes. + */ + #define ENDPOINT_ATTR_ADAPTIVE (2 << 2) + + /** Can be masked with other endpoint descriptor attributes for a \ref USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t descriptor's + * \c Attributes value to indicate that the specified endpoint is synchronized. + * + * \see The USB specification for more details on the possible Endpoint attributes. + */ + #define ENDPOINT_ATTR_SYNC (3 << 2) + //@} + + /** \name Endpoint Descriptor Usage Masks */ + //@{ + /** Can be masked with other endpoint descriptor attributes for a \ref USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t descriptor's + * \c Attributes value to indicate that the specified endpoint is used for data transfers. + * + * \see The USB specification for more details on the possible Endpoint usage attributes. + */ + #define ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA (0 << 4) + + /** Can be masked with other endpoint descriptor attributes for a \ref USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t descriptor's + * \c Attributes value to indicate that the specified endpoint is used for feedback. + * + * \see The USB specification for more details on the possible Endpoint usage attributes. + */ + #define ENDPOINT_USAGE_FEEDBACK (1 << 4) + + /** Can be masked with other endpoint descriptor attributes for a \ref USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t descriptor's + * \c Attributes value to indicate that the specified endpoint is used for implicit feedback. + * + * \see The USB specification for more details on the possible Endpoint usage attributes. + */ + #define ENDPOINT_USAGE_IMPLICIT_FEEDBACK (2 << 4) + //@} + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible standard descriptor types, as given in each descriptor's header. */ + enum USB_DescriptorTypes_t + { + DTYPE_Device = 0x01, /**< Indicates that the descriptor is a device descriptor. */ + DTYPE_Configuration = 0x02, /**< Indicates that the descriptor is a configuration descriptor. */ + DTYPE_String = 0x03, /**< Indicates that the descriptor is a string descriptor. */ + DTYPE_Interface = 0x04, /**< Indicates that the descriptor is an interface descriptor. */ + DTYPE_Endpoint = 0x05, /**< Indicates that the descriptor is an endpoint descriptor. */ + DTYPE_DeviceQualifier = 0x06, /**< Indicates that the descriptor is a device qualifier descriptor. */ + DTYPE_Other = 0x07, /**< Indicates that the descriptor is of other type. */ + DTYPE_InterfacePower = 0x08, /**< Indicates that the descriptor is an interface power descriptor. */ + DTYPE_InterfaceAssociation = 0x0B, /**< Indicates that the descriptor is an interface association descriptor. */ + DTYPE_CSInterface = 0x24, /**< Indicates that the descriptor is a class specific interface descriptor. */ + DTYPE_CSEndpoint = 0x25, /**< Indicates that the descriptor is a class specific endpoint descriptor. */ + }; + + /** Enum for possible Class, Subclass and Protocol values of device and interface descriptors. */ + enum USB_Descriptor_ClassSubclassProtocol_t + { + USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass = 0x00, /**< Descriptor Class value indicating that the device does not belong + * to a particular class at the device level. + */ + USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass = 0x00, /**< Descriptor Subclass value indicating that the device does not belong + * to a particular subclass at the device level. + */ + USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol = 0x00, /**< Descriptor Protocol value indicating that the device does not belong + * to a particular protocol at the device level. + */ + USB_CSCP_VendorSpecificClass = 0xFF, /**< Descriptor Class value indicating that the device/interface belongs + * to a vendor specific class. + */ + USB_CSCP_VendorSpecificSubclass = 0xFF, /**< Descriptor Subclass value indicating that the device/interface belongs + * to a vendor specific subclass. + */ + USB_CSCP_VendorSpecificProtocol = 0xFF, /**< Descriptor Protocol value indicating that the device/interface belongs + * to a vendor specific protocol. + */ + USB_CSCP_IADDeviceClass = 0xEF, /**< Descriptor Class value indicating that the device belongs to the + * Interface Association Descriptor class. + */ + USB_CSCP_IADDeviceSubclass = 0x02, /**< Descriptor Subclass value indicating that the device belongs to the + * Interface Association Descriptor subclass. + */ + USB_CSCP_IADDeviceProtocol = 0x01, /**< Descriptor Protocol value indicating that the device belongs to the + * Interface Association Descriptor protocol. + */ + }; + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief Standard USB Descriptor Header (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for all descriptors' standard header, indicating the descriptor's length and type. This structure + * uses LUFA-specific element names to make each element's purpose clearer. + * + * \see \ref USB_StdDescriptor_Header_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Size; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t Type; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Descriptor_Header_t; + + /** \brief Standard USB Descriptor Header (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for all descriptors' standard header, indicating the descriptor's length and type. This structure + * uses the relevant standard's given element names to ensure compatibility with the standard. + * + * \see \ref USB_Descriptor_Header_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_StdDescriptor_Header_t; + + /** \brief Standard USB Device Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a standard Device Descriptor. This structure uses LUFA-specific element names to make each + * element's purpose clearer. + * + * \see \ref USB_StdDescriptor_Device_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Descriptor header, including type and size. */ + + uint16_t USBSpecification; /**< BCD of the supported USB specification. + * + * \see \ref VERSION_BCD() utility macro. + */ + uint8_t Class; /**< USB device class. */ + uint8_t SubClass; /**< USB device subclass. */ + uint8_t Protocol; /**< USB device protocol. */ + + uint8_t Endpoint0Size; /**< Size of the control (address 0) endpoint's bank in bytes. */ + + uint16_t VendorID; /**< Vendor ID for the USB product. */ + uint16_t ProductID; /**< Unique product ID for the USB product. */ + uint16_t ReleaseNumber; /**< Product release (version) number. + * + * \see \ref VERSION_BCD() utility macro. + */ + uint8_t ManufacturerStrIndex; /**< String index for the manufacturer's name. The + * host will request this string via a separate + * control request for the string descriptor. + * + * \note If no string supplied, use \ref NO_DESCRIPTOR. + */ + uint8_t ProductStrIndex; /**< String index for the product name/details. + * + * \see ManufacturerStrIndex structure entry. + */ + uint8_t SerialNumStrIndex; /**< String index for the product's globally unique hexadecimal + * serial number, in uppercase Unicode ASCII. + * + * \note On some microcontroller models, there is an embedded serial number + * in the chip which can be used for the device serial number. + * To use this serial number, set this to \c USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL. + * On unsupported devices, this will evaluate to \ref NO_DESCRIPTOR + * and will cause the host to generate a pseudo-unique value for the + * device upon insertion. + * + * \see \c ManufacturerStrIndex structure entry. + */ + uint8_t NumberOfConfigurations; /**< Total number of configurations supported by + * the device. + */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Descriptor_Device_t; + + /** \brief Standard USB Device Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a standard Device Descriptor. This structure uses the relevant standard's given element names + * to ensure compatibility with the standard. + * + * \see \ref USB_Descriptor_Device_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + uint16_t bcdUSB; /**< BCD of the supported USB specification. + * + * \see \ref VERSION_BCD() utility macro. + */ + uint8_t bDeviceClass; /**< USB device class. */ + uint8_t bDeviceSubClass; /**< USB device subclass. */ + uint8_t bDeviceProtocol; /**< USB device protocol. */ + uint8_t bMaxPacketSize0; /**< Size of the control (address 0) endpoint's bank in bytes. */ + uint16_t idVendor; /**< Vendor ID for the USB product. */ + uint16_t idProduct; /**< Unique product ID for the USB product. */ + uint16_t bcdDevice; /**< Product release (version) number. + * + * \see \ref VERSION_BCD() utility macro. + */ + uint8_t iManufacturer; /**< String index for the manufacturer's name. The + * host will request this string via a separate + * control request for the string descriptor. + * + * \note If no string supplied, use \ref NO_DESCRIPTOR. + */ + uint8_t iProduct; /**< String index for the product name/details. + * + * \see ManufacturerStrIndex structure entry. + */ + uint8_t iSerialNumber; /**< String index for the product's globally unique hexadecimal + * serial number, in uppercase Unicode ASCII. + * + * \note On some microcontroller models, there is an embedded serial number + * in the chip which can be used for the device serial number. + * To use this serial number, set this to \c USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL. + * On unsupported devices, this will evaluate to \ref NO_DESCRIPTOR + * and will cause the host to generate a pseudo-unique value for the + * device upon insertion. + * + * \see \c ManufacturerStrIndex structure entry. + */ + uint8_t bNumConfigurations; /**< Total number of configurations supported by + * the device. + */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_StdDescriptor_Device_t; + + /** \brief Standard USB Device Qualifier Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a standard Device Qualifier Descriptor. This structure uses LUFA-specific element names + * to make each element's purpose clearer. + * + * \see \ref USB_StdDescriptor_DeviceQualifier_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Descriptor header, including type and size. */ + + uint16_t USBSpecification; /**< BCD of the supported USB specification. + * + * \see \ref VERSION_BCD() utility macro. + */ + uint8_t Class; /**< USB device class. */ + uint8_t SubClass; /**< USB device subclass. */ + uint8_t Protocol; /**< USB device protocol. */ + + uint8_t Endpoint0Size; /**< Size of the control (address 0) endpoint's bank in bytes. */ + uint8_t NumberOfConfigurations; /**< Total number of configurations supported by + * the device. + */ + uint8_t Reserved; /**< Reserved for future use, must be 0. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Descriptor_DeviceQualifier_t; + + /** \brief Standard USB Device Qualifier Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a standard Device Qualifier Descriptor. This structure uses the relevant standard's given element names + * to ensure compatibility with the standard. + * + * \see \ref USB_Descriptor_DeviceQualifier_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific element names. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + uint16_t bcdUSB; /**< BCD of the supported USB specification. + * + * \see \ref VERSION_BCD() utility macro. + */ + uint8_t bDeviceClass; /**< USB device class. */ + uint8_t bDeviceSubClass; /**< USB device subclass. */ + uint8_t bDeviceProtocol; /**< USB device protocol. */ + uint8_t bMaxPacketSize0; /**< Size of the control (address 0) endpoint's bank in bytes. */ + uint8_t bNumConfigurations; /**< Total number of configurations supported by + * the device. + */ + uint8_t bReserved; /**< Reserved for future use, must be 0. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_StdDescriptor_DeviceQualifier_t; + + /** \brief Standard USB Configuration Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a standard Configuration Descriptor header. This structure uses LUFA-specific element names + * to make each element's purpose clearer. + * + * \see \ref USB_StdDescriptor_Configuration_Header_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Descriptor header, including type and size. */ + + uint16_t TotalConfigurationSize; /**< Size of the configuration descriptor header, + * and all sub descriptors inside the configuration. + */ + uint8_t TotalInterfaces; /**< Total number of interfaces in the configuration. */ + + uint8_t ConfigurationNumber; /**< Configuration index of the current configuration. */ + uint8_t ConfigurationStrIndex; /**< Index of a string descriptor describing the configuration. */ + + uint8_t ConfigAttributes; /**< Configuration attributes, comprised of a mask of \c USB_CONFIG_ATTR_* masks. + * On all devices, this should include USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED at a minimum. + */ + + uint8_t MaxPowerConsumption; /**< Maximum power consumption of the device while in the + * current configuration, calculated by the \ref USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA() + * macro. + */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t; + + /** \brief Standard USB Configuration Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a standard Configuration Descriptor header. This structure uses the relevant standard's given element names + * to ensure compatibility with the standard. + * + * \see \ref USB_Descriptor_Device_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + uint16_t wTotalLength; /**< Size of the configuration descriptor header, + * and all sub descriptors inside the configuration. + */ + uint8_t bNumInterfaces; /**< Total number of interfaces in the configuration. */ + uint8_t bConfigurationValue; /**< Configuration index of the current configuration. */ + uint8_t iConfiguration; /**< Index of a string descriptor describing the configuration. */ + uint8_t bmAttributes; /**< Configuration attributes, comprised of a mask of \c USB_CONFIG_ATTR_* masks. + * On all devices, this should include USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED at a minimum. + */ + uint8_t bMaxPower; /**< Maximum power consumption of the device while in the + * current configuration, calculated by the \ref USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA() + * macro. + */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_StdDescriptor_Configuration_Header_t; + + /** \brief Standard USB Interface Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a standard Interface Descriptor. This structure uses LUFA-specific element names + * to make each element's purpose clearer. + * + * \see \ref USB_StdDescriptor_Interface_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Descriptor header, including type and size. */ + + uint8_t InterfaceNumber; /**< Index of the interface in the current configuration. */ + uint8_t AlternateSetting; /**< Alternate setting for the interface number. The same + * interface number can have multiple alternate settings + * with different endpoint configurations, which can be + * selected by the host. + */ + uint8_t TotalEndpoints; /**< Total number of endpoints in the interface. */ + + uint8_t Class; /**< Interface class ID. */ + uint8_t SubClass; /**< Interface subclass ID. */ + uint8_t Protocol; /**< Interface protocol ID. */ + + uint8_t InterfaceStrIndex; /**< Index of the string descriptor describing the interface. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Descriptor_Interface_t; + + /** \brief Standard USB Interface Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a standard Interface Descriptor. This structure uses the relevant standard's given element names + * to ensure compatibility with the standard. + * + * \see \ref USB_Descriptor_Interface_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + uint8_t bInterfaceNumber; /**< Index of the interface in the current configuration. */ + uint8_t bAlternateSetting; /**< Alternate setting for the interface number. The same + * interface number can have multiple alternate settings + * with different endpoint configurations, which can be + * selected by the host. + */ + uint8_t bNumEndpoints; /**< Total number of endpoints in the interface. */ + uint8_t bInterfaceClass; /**< Interface class ID. */ + uint8_t bInterfaceSubClass; /**< Interface subclass ID. */ + uint8_t bInterfaceProtocol; /**< Interface protocol ID. */ + uint8_t iInterface; /**< Index of the string descriptor describing the + * interface. + */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_StdDescriptor_Interface_t; + + /** \brief Standard USB Interface Association Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a standard Interface Association Descriptor. This structure uses LUFA-specific element names + * to make each element's purpose clearer. + * + * This descriptor has been added as a supplement to the USB2.0 standard, in the ECN located at + * <a>http://www.usb.org/developers/docs/InterfaceAssociationDescriptor_ecn.pdf</a>. It allows composite + * devices with multiple interfaces related to the same function to have the multiple interfaces bound + * together at the point of enumeration, loading one generic driver for all the interfaces in the single + * function. Read the ECN for more information. + * + * \see \ref USB_StdDescriptor_Interface_Association_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Descriptor header, including type and size. */ + + uint8_t FirstInterfaceIndex; /**< Index of the first associated interface. */ + uint8_t TotalInterfaces; /**< Total number of associated interfaces. */ + + uint8_t Class; /**< Interface class ID. */ + uint8_t SubClass; /**< Interface subclass ID. */ + uint8_t Protocol; /**< Interface protocol ID. */ + + uint8_t IADStrIndex; /**< Index of the string descriptor describing the + * interface association. + */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Descriptor_Interface_Association_t; + + /** \brief Standard USB Interface Association Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a standard Interface Association Descriptor. This structure uses the relevant standard's given + * element names to ensure compatibility with the standard. + * + * This descriptor has been added as a supplement to the USB2.0 standard, in the ECN located at + * <a>http://www.usb.org/developers/docs/InterfaceAssociationDescriptor_ecn.pdf</a>. It allows composite + * devices with multiple interfaces related to the same function to have the multiple interfaces bound + * together at the point of enumeration, loading one generic driver for all the interfaces in the single + * function. Read the ECN for more information. + * + * \see \ref USB_Descriptor_Interface_Association_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific + * element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a value + * given by the specific class. + */ + uint8_t bFirstInterface; /**< Index of the first associated interface. */ + uint8_t bInterfaceCount; /**< Total number of associated interfaces. */ + uint8_t bFunctionClass; /**< Interface class ID. */ + uint8_t bFunctionSubClass; /**< Interface subclass ID. */ + uint8_t bFunctionProtocol; /**< Interface protocol ID. */ + uint8_t iFunction; /**< Index of the string descriptor describing the + * interface association. + */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_StdDescriptor_Interface_Association_t; + + /** \brief Standard USB Endpoint Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a standard Endpoint Descriptor. This structure uses LUFA-specific element names + * to make each element's purpose clearer. + * + * \see \ref USB_StdDescriptor_Endpoint_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Descriptor header, including type and size. */ + + uint8_t EndpointAddress; /**< Logical address of the endpoint within the device for the current + * configuration, including direction mask. + */ + uint8_t Attributes; /**< Endpoint attributes, comprised of a mask of the endpoint type (EP_TYPE_*) + * and attributes (ENDPOINT_ATTR_*) masks. + */ + uint16_t EndpointSize; /**< Size of the endpoint bank, in bytes. This indicates the maximum packet + * size that the endpoint can receive at a time. + */ + uint8_t PollingIntervalMS; /**< Polling interval in milliseconds for the endpoint if it is an INTERRUPT + * or ISOCHRONOUS type. + */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t; + + /** \brief Standard USB Endpoint Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a standard Endpoint Descriptor. This structure uses the relevant standard's given + * element names to ensure compatibility with the standard. + * + * \see \ref USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t for the version of this type with non-standard LUFA specific + * element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t or a + * value given by the specific class. + */ + uint8_t bEndpointAddress; /**< Logical address of the endpoint within the device for the current + * configuration, including direction mask. + */ + uint8_t bmAttributes; /**< Endpoint attributes, comprised of a mask of the endpoint type (EP_TYPE_*) + * and attributes (ENDPOINT_ATTR_*) masks. + */ + uint16_t wMaxPacketSize; /**< Size of the endpoint bank, in bytes. This indicates the maximum packet size + * that the endpoint can receive at a time. + */ + uint8_t bInterval; /**< Polling interval in milliseconds for the endpoint if it is an INTERRUPT or + * ISOCHRONOUS type. + */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_StdDescriptor_Endpoint_t; + + /** \brief Standard USB String Descriptor (LUFA naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a standard string descriptor. Unlike other standard descriptors, the length + * of the descriptor for placement in the descriptor header must be determined by the \ref USB_STRING_LEN() + * macro rather than by the size of the descriptor structure, as the length is not fixed. + * + * This structure should also be used for string index 0, which contains the supported language IDs for + * the device as an array. + * + * This structure uses LUFA-specific element names to make each element's purpose clearer. + * + * \see \ref USB_StdDescriptor_String_t for the version of this type with standard element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Descriptor header, including type and size. */ + + #if (((ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) || (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA)) && !defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + wchar_t UnicodeString[]; + #else + uint16_t UnicodeString[]; /**< String data, as unicode characters (alternatively, + * string language IDs). If normal ASCII characters are + * to be used, they must be added as an array of characters + * rather than a normal C string so that they are widened to + * Unicode size. + * + * Under GCC, strings prefixed with the "L" character (before + * the opening string quotation mark) are considered to be + * Unicode strings, and may be used instead of an explicit + * array of ASCII characters on little endian devices with + * UTF-16-LE \c wchar_t encoding. + */ + #endif + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Descriptor_String_t; + + /** \brief Standard USB String Descriptor (USB-IF naming conventions). + * + * Type define for a standard string descriptor. Unlike other standard descriptors, the length + * of the descriptor for placement in the descriptor header must be determined by the \ref USB_STRING_LEN() + * macro rather than by the size of the descriptor structure, as the length is not fixed. + * + * This structure should also be used for string index 0, which contains the supported language IDs for + * the device as an array. + * + * This structure uses the relevant standard's given element names to ensure compatibility with the standard. + * + * \see \ref USB_Descriptor_String_t for the version of this type with with non-standard LUFA specific + * element names. + * + * \note Regardless of CPU architecture, these values should be stored as little endian. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bLength; /**< Size of the descriptor, in bytes. */ + uint8_t bDescriptorType; /**< Type of the descriptor, either a value in \ref USB_DescriptorTypes_t + * or a value given by the specific class. + */ + uint16_t bString[]; /**< String data, as unicode characters (alternatively, string language IDs). + * If normal ASCII characters are to be used, they must be added as an array + * of characters rather than a normal C string so that they are widened to + * Unicode size. + * + * Under GCC, strings prefixed with the "L" character (before the opening string + * quotation mark) are considered to be Unicode strings, and may be used instead + * of an explicit array of ASCII characters. + */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_StdDescriptor_String_t; + + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/StdRequestType.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/StdRequestType.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7297806962 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/StdRequestType.h @@ -0,0 +1,258 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB control endpoint request definitions. + * \copydetails Group_StdRequest + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USB + * \defgroup Group_StdRequest Standard USB Requests + * \brief USB control endpoint request definitions. + * + * This module contains definitions for the various control request parameters, so that the request + * details (such as data direction, request recipient, etc.) can be extracted via masking. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __STDREQTYPE_H__ +#define __STDREQTYPE_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "USBMode.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Mask for the request type parameter, to indicate the direction of the request data (Host to Device + * or Device to Host). The result of this mask should then be compared to the request direction masks. + * + * \see \c REQDIR_* macros for masks indicating the request data direction. + */ + #define CONTROL_REQTYPE_DIRECTION 0x80 + + /** Mask for the request type parameter, to indicate the type of request (Device, Class or Vendor + * Specific). The result of this mask should then be compared to the request type masks. + * + * \see \c REQTYPE_* macros for masks indicating the request type. + */ + #define CONTROL_REQTYPE_TYPE 0x60 + + /** Mask for the request type parameter, to indicate the recipient of the request (Device, Interface + * Endpoint or Other). The result of this mask should then be compared to the request recipient + * masks. + * + * \see \c REQREC_* macros for masks indicating the request recipient. + */ + #define CONTROL_REQTYPE_RECIPIENT 0x1F + + /** \name Control Request Data Direction Masks */ + //@{ + /** Request data direction mask, indicating that the request data will flow from host to device. + * + * \see \ref CONTROL_REQTYPE_DIRECTION macro. + */ + #define REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE (0 << 7) + + /** Request data direction mask, indicating that the request data will flow from device to host. + * + * \see \ref CONTROL_REQTYPE_DIRECTION macro. + */ + #define REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST (1 << 7) + //@} + + /** \name Control Request Type Masks */ + //@{ + /** Request type mask, indicating that the request is a standard request. + * + * \see \ref CONTROL_REQTYPE_TYPE macro. + */ + #define REQTYPE_STANDARD (0 << 5) + + /** Request type mask, indicating that the request is a class-specific request. + * + * \see \ref CONTROL_REQTYPE_TYPE macro. + */ + #define REQTYPE_CLASS (1 << 5) + + /** Request type mask, indicating that the request is a vendor specific request. + * + * \see \ref CONTROL_REQTYPE_TYPE macro. + */ + #define REQTYPE_VENDOR (2 << 5) + //@} + + /** \name Control Request Recipient Masks */ + //@{ + /** Request recipient mask, indicating that the request is to be issued to the device as a whole. + * + * \see \ref CONTROL_REQTYPE_RECIPIENT macro. + */ + #define REQREC_DEVICE (0 << 0) + + /** Request recipient mask, indicating that the request is to be issued to an interface in the + * currently selected configuration. + * + * \see \ref CONTROL_REQTYPE_RECIPIENT macro. + */ + #define REQREC_INTERFACE (1 << 0) + + /** Request recipient mask, indicating that the request is to be issued to an endpoint in the + * currently selected configuration. + * + * \see \ref CONTROL_REQTYPE_RECIPIENT macro. + */ + #define REQREC_ENDPOINT (2 << 0) + + /** Request recipient mask, indicating that the request is to be issued to an unspecified element + * in the currently selected configuration. + * + * \see \ref CONTROL_REQTYPE_RECIPIENT macro. + */ + #define REQREC_OTHER (3 << 0) + //@} + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** \brief Standard USB Control Request + * + * Type define for a standard USB control request. + * + * \see The USB 2.0 specification for more information on standard control requests. + */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t bmRequestType; /**< Type of the request. */ + uint8_t bRequest; /**< Request command code. */ + uint16_t wValue; /**< wValue parameter of the request. */ + uint16_t wIndex; /**< wIndex parameter of the request. */ + uint16_t wLength; /**< Length of the data to transfer in bytes. */ + } ATTR_PACKED USB_Request_Header_t; + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enumeration for the various standard request commands. These commands are applicable when the + * request type is \ref REQTYPE_STANDARD (with the exception of \ref REQ_GetDescriptor, which is always + * handled regardless of the request type value). + * + * \see Chapter 9 of the USB 2.0 Specification. + */ + enum USB_Control_Request_t + { + REQ_GetStatus = 0, /**< Implemented in the library for device and endpoint recipients. Passed + * to the user application for other recipients via the + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event when received in + * device mode. */ + REQ_ClearFeature = 1, /**< Implemented in the library for device and endpoint recipients. Passed + * to the user application for other recipients via the + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event when received in + * device mode. */ + REQ_SetFeature = 3, /**< Implemented in the library for device and endpoint recipients. Passed + * to the user application for other recipients via the + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event when received in + * device mode. */ + REQ_SetAddress = 5, /**< Implemented in the library for the device recipient. Passed + * to the user application for other recipients via the + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event when received in + * device mode. */ + REQ_GetDescriptor = 6, /**< Implemented in the library for device and interface recipients. Passed to the + * user application for other recipients via the + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event when received in + * device mode. */ + REQ_SetDescriptor = 7, /**< Not implemented in the library, passed to the user application + * via the \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event when received in + * device mode. */ + REQ_GetConfiguration = 8, /**< Implemented in the library for the device recipient. Passed + * to the user application for other recipients via the + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event when received in + * device mode. */ + REQ_SetConfiguration = 9, /**< Implemented in the library for the device recipient. Passed + * to the user application for other recipients via the + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event when received in + * device mode. */ + REQ_GetInterface = 10, /**< Not implemented in the library, passed to the user application + * via the \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event when received in + * device mode. */ + REQ_SetInterface = 11, /**< Not implemented in the library, passed to the user application + * via the \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event when received in + * device mode. */ + REQ_SynchFrame = 12, /**< Not implemented in the library, passed to the user application + * via the \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event when received in + * device mode. */ + }; + + /** Feature Selector values for Set Feature and Clear Feature standard control requests directed to the device, interface + * and endpoint recipients. + */ + enum USB_Feature_Selectors_t + { + FEATURE_SEL_EndpointHalt = 0x00, /**< Feature selector for Clear Feature or Set Feature commands. When + * used in a Set Feature or Clear Feature request this indicates that an + * endpoint (whose address is given elsewhere in the request) should have + * its stall condition changed. + */ + FEATURE_SEL_DeviceRemoteWakeup = 0x01, /**< Feature selector for Device level Remote Wakeup enable set or clear. + * This feature can be controlled by the host on devices which indicate + * remote wakeup support in their descriptors to selectively disable or + * enable remote wakeup. + */ + FEATURE_SEL_TestMode = 0x02, /**< Feature selector for Test Mode features, used to test the USB controller + * to check for incorrect operation. + */ + }; + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define FEATURE_SELFPOWERED_ENABLED (1 << 0) + #define FEATURE_REMOTE_WAKEUP_ENABLED (1 << 1) + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Device_UC3.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Device_UC3.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3aa1433f53 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Device_UC3.c @@ -0,0 +1,51 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + +#include "../Device.h" + +void USB_Device_SendRemoteWakeup(void) +{ + USB_CLK_Unfreeze(); + + AVR32_USBB.UDCON.rmwkup = true; + while (AVR32_USBB.UDCON.rmwkup); +} + +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Device_UC3.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Device_UC3.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fd6dbde887 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Device_UC3.h @@ -0,0 +1,267 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Device definitions for the AVR32 UC3 microcontrollers. + * \copydetails Group_Device_UC3 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Device + * \defgroup Group_Device_UC3 Device Management (UC3) + * \brief USB Device definitions for the AVR32 UC3 microcontrollers. + * + * Architecture specific USB Device definitions for the Atmel 32-bit UC3 AVR microcontrollers. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __USBDEVICE_UC3_H__ +#define __USBDEVICE_UC3_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../USBController.h" + #include "../StdDescriptors.h" + #include "../USBInterrupt.h" + #include "../Endpoint.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** \name USB Device Mode Option Masks */ + //@{ + /** Mask for the Options parameter of the \ref USB_Init() function. This indicates that the + * USB interface should be initialized in low speed (1.5Mb/s) mode. + * + * \note Restrictions apply on the number, size and type of endpoints which can be used + * when running in low speed mode - please refer to the USB 2.0 specification. + */ + #define USB_DEVICE_OPT_LOWSPEED (1 << 0) + + /** Mask for the Options parameter of the \ref USB_Init() function. This indicates that the + * USB interface should be initialized in full speed (12Mb/s) mode. + */ + #define USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED (0 << 0) + + #if defined(USB_SERIES_UC3A3_AVR32) || defined(USB_SERIES_UC3A4_AVR32) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Mask for the Options parameter of the \ref USB_Init() function. This indicates that the + * USB interface should be initialized in high speed (480Mb/s) mode. + */ + #define USB_DEVICE_OPT_HIGHSPEED (1 << 1) + #endif + //@} + + #if (!defined(NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL) && \ + (defined(USB_SERIES_UC3A3_AVR32) || defined(USB_SERIES_UC3A4_AVR32) || \ + defined(__DOXYGEN__))) + /** String descriptor index for the device's unique serial number string descriptor within the device. + * This unique serial number is used by the host to associate resources to the device (such as drivers or COM port + * number allocations) to a device regardless of the port it is plugged in to on the host. Some microcontrollers contain + * a unique serial number internally, and setting the device descriptors serial number string index to this value + * will cause it to use the internal serial number. + * + * On unsupported devices, this will evaluate to \ref NO_DESCRIPTOR and so will force the host to create a pseudo-serial + * number for the device. + */ + #define USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL 0xDC + + /** Length of the device's unique internal serial number, in bits, if present on the selected microcontroller + * model. + */ + #define INTERNAL_SERIAL_LENGTH_BITS 120 + + /** Start address of the internal serial number, in the appropriate address space, if present on the selected microcontroller + * model. + */ + #define INTERNAL_SERIAL_START_ADDRESS 0x80800204 + #else + #define USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL NO_DESCRIPTOR + + #define INTERNAL_SERIAL_LENGTH_BITS 0 + #define INTERNAL_SERIAL_START_ADDRESS 0 + #endif + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Sends a Remote Wakeup request to the host. This signals to the host that the device should + * be taken out of suspended mode, and communications should resume. + * + * Typically, this is implemented so that HID devices (mice, keyboards, etc.) can wake up the + * host computer when the host has suspended all USB devices to enter a low power state. + * + * \note This function should only be used if the device has indicated to the host that it + * supports the Remote Wakeup feature in the device descriptors, and should only be + * issued if the host is currently allowing remote wakeup events from the device (i.e., + * the \ref USB_Device_RemoteWakeupEnabled flag is set). When the \c NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP + * compile time option is used, this function is unavailable. + * + * \note The USB clock must be running for this function to operate. If the stack is initialized with + * the \ref USB_OPT_MANUAL_PLL option enabled, the user must ensure that the PLL is running + * before attempting to call this function. + * + * \see \ref Group_StdDescriptors for more information on the RMWAKEUP feature and device descriptors. + */ + void USB_Device_SendRemoteWakeup(void); + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Returns the current USB frame number, when in device mode. Every millisecond the USB bus is active (i.e. enumerated to a host) + * the frame number is incremented by one. + * + * \return Current USB frame number from the USB controller. + */ + static inline uint16_t USB_Device_GetFrameNumber(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint16_t USB_Device_GetFrameNumber(void) + { + return AVR32_USBB.UDFNUM.fnum; + } + + #if !defined(NO_SOF_EVENTS) + /** Enables the device mode Start Of Frame events. When enabled, this causes the + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame() event to fire once per millisecond, synchronized to the USB bus, + * at the start of each USB frame when enumerated in device mode. + * + * \note Not available when the \c NO_SOF_EVENTS compile time token is defined. + */ + static inline void USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(void) + { + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_SOFI); + } + + /** Disables the device mode Start Of Frame events. When disabled, this stops the firing of the + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame() event when enumerated in device mode. + * + * \note Not available when the \c NO_SOF_EVENTS compile time token is defined. + */ + static inline void USB_Device_DisableSOFEvents(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Device_DisableSOFEvents(void) + { + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_SOFI); + } + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Inline Functions: */ + static inline void USB_Device_SetLowSpeed(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Device_SetLowSpeed(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.UDCON.ls = true; + } + + static inline void USB_Device_SetFullSpeed(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Device_SetFullSpeed(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.UDCON.ls = false; + #if defined(USB_DEVICE_OPT_HIGHSPEED) + AVR32_USBB.UDCON.spdconf = 3; + #endif + } + + #if defined(USB_DEVICE_OPT_HIGHSPEED) + static inline void USB_Device_SetHighSpeed(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Device_SetHighSpeed(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.UDCON.ls = false; + AVR32_USBB.UDCON.spdconf = 0; + } + #endif + + static inline void USB_Device_SetDeviceAddress(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Device_SetDeviceAddress(const uint8_t Address) + { + AVR32_USBB.UDCON.uadd = Address; + } + + static inline void USB_Device_EnableDeviceAddress(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Device_EnableDeviceAddress(const uint8_t Address) + { + (void)Address; + + AVR32_USBB.UDCON.adden = true; + } + + static inline bool USB_Device_IsAddressSet(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline bool USB_Device_IsAddressSet(void) + { + return AVR32_USBB.UDCON.adden; + } + + #if (USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL != NO_DESCRIPTOR) + static inline void USB_Device_GetSerialString(uint16_t* const UnicodeString) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void USB_Device_GetSerialString(uint16_t* const UnicodeString) + { + uint_reg_t CurrentGlobalInt = GetGlobalInterruptMask(); + GlobalInterruptDisable(); + + uint8_t* SigReadAddress = (uint8_t*)INTERNAL_SERIAL_START_ADDRESS; + + for (uint8_t SerialCharNum = 0; SerialCharNum < (INTERNAL_SERIAL_LENGTH_BITS / 4); SerialCharNum++) + { + uint8_t SerialByte = *SigReadAddress; + + if (SerialCharNum & 0x01) + { + SerialByte >>= 4; + SigReadAddress++; + } + + SerialByte &= 0x0F; + + UnicodeString[SerialCharNum] = cpu_to_le16((SerialByte >= 10) ? + (('A' - 10) + SerialByte) : ('0' + SerialByte)); + } + + SetGlobalInterruptMask(CurrentGlobalInt); + } + #endif + + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/EndpointStream_UC3.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/EndpointStream_UC3.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..04f6e97d65 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/EndpointStream_UC3.c @@ -0,0 +1,235 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + +#include "EndpointStream_UC3.h" + +#if !defined(CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE) +uint8_t Endpoint_Discard_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + uint16_t BytesInTransfer = 0; + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + Length -= *BytesProcessed; + + while (Length) + { + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + *BytesProcessed += BytesInTransfer; + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + } + else + { + Endpoint_Discard_8(); + + Length--; + BytesInTransfer++; + } + } + + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +uint8_t Endpoint_Null_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + uint16_t BytesInTransfer = 0; + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + Length -= *BytesProcessed; + + while (Length) + { + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + *BytesProcessed += BytesInTransfer; + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + } + else + { + Endpoint_Write_8(0); + + Length--; + BytesInTransfer++; + } + } + + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +/* The following abuses the C preprocessor in order to copy-paste common code with slight alterations, + * so that the code needs to be written once. It is a crude form of templating to reduce code maintenance. */ + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearIN() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(*BufferPtr) +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearIN() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(*BufferPtr) +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE void* +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearOUT() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) *BufferPtr = Endpoint_Read_8() +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_Stream_BE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE void* +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearOUT() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) *BufferPtr = Endpoint_Read_8() +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + +#if defined(ARCH_HAS_FLASH_ADDRESS_SPACE) + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_PStream_LE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* + #define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearIN() + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(pgm_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_PStream_BE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* + #define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearIN() + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(pgm_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" +#endif + +#if defined(ARCH_HAS_EEPROM_ADDRESS_SPACE) + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_EStream_LE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* + #define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearIN() + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(eeprom_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_EStream_BE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* + #define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearIN() + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(eeprom_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_EStream_LE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE void* + #define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearOUT() + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) eeprom_update_byte(BufferPtr, Endpoint_Read_8()) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_EStream_BE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE void* + #define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearOUT() + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) eeprom_update_byte(BufferPtr, Endpoint_Read_8()) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" +#endif + +#endif + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(*BufferPtr) +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_BE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(*BufferPtr) +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) *BufferPtr = Endpoint_Read_8() +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_BE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) *BufferPtr = Endpoint_Read_8() +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c" + +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/EndpointStream_UC3.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/EndpointStream_UC3.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8b1c10eb09 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/EndpointStream_UC3.h @@ -0,0 +1,438 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Endpoint data stream transmission and reception management for the AVR32 UC3 microcontrollers. + * \copydetails Group_EndpointStreamRW_UC3 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_EndpointStreamRW + * \defgroup Group_EndpointStreamRW_UC3 Read/Write of Multi-Byte Streams (UC3) + * \brief Endpoint data stream transmission and reception management for the Atmel AVR32 UC3 architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing of data streams from + * and to endpoints. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __ENDPOINT_STREAM_UC3_H__ +#define __ENDPOINT_STREAM_UC3_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../USBMode.h" + #include "../USBTask.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** \name Stream functions for null data */ + //@{ + + /** Reads and discards the given number of bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank, + * discarding fully read packets from the host as needed. The last packet is not automatically + * discarded once the remaining bytes has been read; the user is responsible for manually + * discarding the last packet from the host via the \ref Endpoint_ClearOUT() macro. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, + * failing or succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid + * storage location, the transfer will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time + * the endpoint bank becomes empty while there is still data to process (and after the current + * packet has been acknowledged) the BytesProcessed location will be updated with the total number + * of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed + * in the user code - to continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters + * and it will resume until the BytesProcessed value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Discard_Stream(512, NULL)) != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Discard_Stream(512, &BytesProcessed)) == ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note This routine should not be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to discard via the currently selected endpoint. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Discard_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed); + + /** Writes a given number of zeroed bytes to the currently selected endpoint's bank, sending + * full packets to the host as needed. The last packet is not automatically sent once the + * remaining bytes have been written; the user is responsible for manually sending the last + * packet to the host via the \ref Endpoint_ClearIN() macro. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, + * failing or succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid + * storage location, the transfer will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time + * the endpoint bank becomes full while there is still data to process (and after the current + * packet transmission has been initiated) the BytesProcessed location will be updated with the + * total number of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed + * in the user code - to continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters + * and it will resume until the BytesProcessed value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Null_Stream(512, NULL)) != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Null_Stream(512, &BytesProcessed)) == ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note This routine should not be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \param[in] Length Number of zero bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Null_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed); + + //@} + + /** \name Stream functions for RAM source/destination data */ + //@{ + + /** Writes the given number of bytes to the endpoint from the given buffer in little endian, + * sending full packets to the host as needed. The last packet filled is not automatically sent; + * the user is responsible for manually sending the last written packet to the host via the + * \ref Endpoint_ClearIN() macro. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, + * failing or succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid + * storage location, the transfer will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time + * the endpoint bank becomes full while there is still data to process (and after the current + * packet transmission has been initiated) the BytesProcessed location will be updated with the + * total number of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed + * in the user code - to continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters + * and it will resume until the BytesProcessed value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * NULL)) != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * &BytesProcessed)) == ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note This routine should not be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Writes the given number of bytes to the endpoint from the given buffer in big endian, + * sending full packets to the host as needed. The last packet filled is not automatically sent; + * the user is responsible for manually sending the last written packet to the host via the + * \ref Endpoint_ClearIN() macro. + * + * \note This routine should not be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads the given number of bytes from the endpoint from the given buffer in little endian, + * discarding fully read packets from the host as needed. The last packet is not automatically + * discarded once the remaining bytes has been read; the user is responsible for manually + * discarding the last packet from the host via the \ref Endpoint_ClearOUT() macro. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, + * failing or succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid + * storage location, the transfer will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time + * the endpoint bank becomes empty while there is still data to process (and after the current + * packet has been acknowledged) the BytesProcessed location will be updated with the total number + * of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed + * in the user code - to continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters + * and it will resume until the BytesProcessed value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * NULL)) != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * &BytesProcessed)) == ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note This routine should not be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads the given number of bytes from the endpoint from the given buffer in big endian, + * discarding fully read packets from the host as needed. The last packet is not automatically + * discarded once the remaining bytes has been read; the user is responsible for manually + * discarding the last packet from the host via the \ref Endpoint_ClearOUT() macro. + * + * \note This routine should not be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_Stream_BE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Writes the given number of bytes to the CONTROL type endpoint from the given buffer in little endian, + * sending full packets to the host as needed. The host OUT acknowledgement is not automatically cleared + * in both failure and success states; the user is responsible for manually clearing the status OUT packet + * to finalize the transfer's status stage via the \ref Endpoint_ClearOUT() macro. + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Writes the given number of bytes to the CONTROL type endpoint from the given buffer in big endian, + * sending full packets to the host as needed. The host OUT acknowledgement is not automatically cleared + * in both failure and success states; the user is responsible for manually clearing the status OUT packet + * to finalize the transfer's status stage via the \ref Endpoint_ClearOUT() macro. + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_BE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads the given number of bytes from the CONTROL endpoint from the given buffer in little endian, + * discarding fully read packets from the host as needed. The device IN acknowledgement is not + * automatically sent after success or failure states; the user is responsible for manually sending the + * status IN packet to finalize the transfer's status stage via the \ref Endpoint_ClearIN() macro. + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads the given number of bytes from the CONTROL endpoint from the given buffer in big endian, + * discarding fully read packets from the host as needed. The device IN acknowledgement is not + * automatically sent after success or failure states; the user is responsible for manually sending the + * status IN packet to finalize the transfer's status stage via the \ref Endpoint_ClearIN() macro. + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_BE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + //@} + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Endpoint_UC3.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Endpoint_UC3.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7e24672c50 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Endpoint_UC3.c @@ -0,0 +1,196 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + +#include "../Endpoint.h" + +#if !defined(FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE) +uint8_t USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize = ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP_DEFAULT_SIZE; +#endif + +volatile uint32_t USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint = ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP; +volatile uint8_t* USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS]; + +bool Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(const USB_Endpoint_Table_t* const Table, + const uint8_t Entries) +{ + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < Entries; i++) + { + if (!(Table[i].Address)) + continue; + + if (!(Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(Table[i].Address, Table[i].Type, Table[i].Size, Table[i].Banks))) + { + return false; + } + } + + return true; +} + +bool Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint_Prv(const uint8_t Number, + const uint32_t UECFG0Data) +{ + USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[Number] = &AVR32_USBB_SLAVE[Number * ENDPOINT_HSB_ADDRESS_SPACE_SIZE]; + +#if defined(CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE) || defined(ORDERED_EP_CONFIG) + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(Number); + Endpoint_EnableEndpoint(); + + (&AVR32_USBB.uecfg0)[Number] = 0; + (&AVR32_USBB.uecfg0)[Number] = UECFG0Data; + + return Endpoint_IsConfigured(); +#else + for (uint8_t EPNum = Number; EPNum < ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS; EPNum++) + { + uint32_t UECFG0Temp; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(EPNum); + + if (EPNum == Number) + { + UECFG0Temp = UECFG0Data; + } + else + { + UECFG0Temp = (&AVR32_USBB.uecfg0)[EPNum]; + } + + if (!(UECFG0Temp & AVR32_USBB_ALLOC_MASK)) + continue; + + Endpoint_DisableEndpoint(); + (&AVR32_USBB.uecfg0)[EPNum] &= ~AVR32_USBB_ALLOC_MASK; + + Endpoint_EnableEndpoint(); + (&AVR32_USBB.uecfg0)[EPNum] = UECFG0Temp; + + if (!(Endpoint_IsConfigured())) + return false; + } + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(Number); + return true; +#endif +} + +void Endpoint_ClearEndpoints(void) +{ + for (uint8_t EPNum = 0; EPNum < ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS; EPNum++) + { + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(EPNum); + (&AVR32_USBB.uecfg0)[EPNum] = 0; + (&AVR32_USBB.uecon0clr)[EPNum] = -1; + USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[EPNum] = &AVR32_USBB_SLAVE[EPNum * 0x10000]; + Endpoint_DisableEndpoint(); + } +} + +void Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(void) +{ + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType & REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST) + { + while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + else + { + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } +} + +#if !defined(CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE) +uint8_t Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(void) +{ + #if (USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS < 0xFF) + uint8_t TimeoutMSRem = USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS; + #else + uint16_t TimeoutMSRem = USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS; + #endif + + uint16_t PreviousFrameNumber = USB_Device_GetFrameNumber(); + + for (;;) + { + if (Endpoint_GetEndpointDirection() == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + { + if (Endpoint_IsINReady()) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError; + } + else + { + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError; + } + + uint8_t USB_DeviceState_LCL = USB_DeviceState; + + if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + else if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Suspended) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_BusSuspended; + else if (Endpoint_IsStalled()) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_EndpointStalled; + + uint16_t CurrentFrameNumber = USB_Device_GetFrameNumber(); + + if (CurrentFrameNumber != PreviousFrameNumber) + { + PreviousFrameNumber = CurrentFrameNumber; + + if (!(TimeoutMSRem--)) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_Timeout; + } + } +} +#endif + +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Endpoint_UC3.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Endpoint_UC3.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..32d6a9b768 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Endpoint_UC3.h @@ -0,0 +1,794 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Endpoint definitions for the AVR32 UC3 microcontrollers. + * \copydetails Group_EndpointManagement_UC3 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_EndpointRW + * \defgroup Group_EndpointRW_UC3 Endpoint Data Reading and Writing (UC3) + * \brief Endpoint data read/write definitions for the Atmel AVR32 UC3 architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing from and to endpoints. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW + * \defgroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_UC3 Read/Write of Primitive Data Types (UC3) + * \brief Endpoint primitive read/write definitions for the Atmel AVR32 UC3 architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing of primitive data types + * from and to endpoints. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement + * \defgroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_UC3 Endpoint Packet Management (UC3) + * \brief Endpoint packet management definitions for the Atmel AVR32 UC3 architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to packet management of endpoints. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_EndpointManagement + * \defgroup Group_EndpointManagement_UC3 Endpoint Management (UC3) + * \brief Endpoint management definitions for the Atmel AVR32 UC3 architecture. + * + * Functions, macros and enums related to endpoint management when in USB Device mode. This + * module contains the endpoint management macros, as well as endpoint interrupt and data + * send/receive functions for various data types. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __ENDPOINT_UC3_H__ +#define __ENDPOINT_UC3_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../USBTask.h" + #include "../USBInterrupt.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define ENDPOINT_HSB_ADDRESS_SPACE_SIZE (64 * 1024UL) + + /* Inline Functions: */ + static inline uint32_t Endpoint_BytesToEPSizeMask(const uint16_t Bytes) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_CONST + ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint32_t Endpoint_BytesToEPSizeMask(const uint16_t Bytes) + { + uint8_t MaskVal = 0; + uint16_t CheckBytes = 8; + + while (CheckBytes < Bytes) + { + MaskVal++; + CheckBytes <<= 1; + } + + return (MaskVal << AVR32_USBB_EPSIZE_OFFSET); + } + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void Endpoint_ClearEndpoints(void); + bool Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint_Prv(const uint8_t Number, + const uint32_t UECFGXData); + + /* External Variables: */ + extern volatile uint32_t USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint; + extern volatile uint8_t* USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[]; + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + #if (!defined(FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + /** Default size of the default control endpoint's bank, until altered by the control endpoint bank size + * value in the device descriptor. Not available if the \c FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE token is defined. + */ + #define ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP_DEFAULT_SIZE 8 + #endif + + #if !defined(CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #if defined(USB_SERIES_UC3A3_AVR32) || defined(USB_SERIES_UC3A4_AVR32) + #define ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS 8 + #else + /** Total number of endpoints (including the default control endpoint at address 0) which may + * be used in the device. Different AVR models support different amounts of endpoints, + * this value reflects the maximum number of endpoints for the currently selected AVR model. + */ + #define ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS 7 + #endif + #else + #define ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS 1 + #endif + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible error return codes of the \ref Endpoint_WaitUntilReady() function. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointRW_UC3 + */ + enum Endpoint_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t + { + ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError = 0, /**< Endpoint is ready for next packet, no error. */ + ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_EndpointStalled = 1, /**< The endpoint was stalled during the stream + * transfer by the host or device. + */ + ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected = 2, /**< Device was disconnected from the host while + * waiting for the endpoint to become ready. + */ + ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_BusSuspended = 3, /**< The USB bus has been suspended by the host and + * no USB endpoint traffic can occur until the bus + * has resumed. + */ + ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_Timeout = 4, /**< The host failed to accept or send the next packet + * within the software timeout period set by the + * \ref USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS macro. + */ + }; + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Configures the specified endpoint address with the given endpoint type, bank size and number of hardware + * banks. Once configured, the endpoint may be read from or written to, depending on its direction. + * + * \param[in] Address Endpoint address to configure. + * + * \param[in] Type Type of endpoint to configure, a \c EP_TYPE_* mask. Not all endpoint types + * are available on Low Speed USB devices - refer to the USB 2.0 specification. + * + * \param[in] Size Size of the endpoint's bank, where packets are stored before they are transmitted + * to the USB host, or after they have been received from the USB host (depending on + * the endpoint's data direction). The bank size must indicate the maximum packet size + * that the endpoint can handle. + * + * \param[in] Banks Number of hardware banks to use for the endpoint being configured. + * + * \attention When the \c ORDERED_EP_CONFIG compile time option is used, Endpoints <b>must</b> be configured in + * ascending order, or bank corruption will occur. + * + * \note Different endpoints may have different maximum packet sizes based on the endpoint's index - refer to + * the chosen microcontroller model's datasheet to determine the maximum bank size for each endpoint. + * \n\n + * + * \note The default control endpoint should not be manually configured by the user application, as + * it is automatically configured by the library internally. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine will automatically select the specified endpoint upon success. Upon failure, the endpoint + * which failed to reconfigure correctly will be selected. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the configuration succeeded, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(const uint8_t Address, + const uint8_t Type, + const uint16_t Size, + const uint8_t Banks) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(const uint8_t Address, + const uint8_t Type, + const uint16_t Size, + const uint8_t Banks) + { + uint8_t Number = (Address & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK); + + if (Number >= ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS) + return false; + + return Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint_Prv(Number, + (AVR32_USBB_ALLOC_MASK | + ((uint32_t)Type << AVR32_USBB_EPTYPE_OFFSET) | + ((Address & ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) ? AVR32_USBB_UECFG0_EPDIR_MASK : 0) | + ((Banks > 1) ? AVR32_USBB_UECFG0_EPBK_SINGLE : AVR32_USBB_UECFG0_EPBK_DOUBLE) | + Endpoint_BytesToEPSizeMask(Size))); + } + + /** Indicates the number of bytes currently stored in the current endpoint's selected bank. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointRW_UC3 + * + * \return Total number of bytes in the currently selected Endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint16_t Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint16_t Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint(void) + { + return (&AVR32_USBB.UESTA0)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].byct; + } + + /** Determines the currently selected endpoint's direction. + * + * \return The currently selected endpoint's direction, as a \c ENDPOINT_DIR_* mask. + */ + static inline uint32_t Endpoint_GetEndpointDirection(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint32_t Endpoint_GetEndpointDirection(void) + { + return ((&AVR32_USBB.UECFG0)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].epdir ? ENDPOINT_DIR_IN : ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT); + } + + /** Get the endpoint address of the currently selected endpoint. This is typically used to save + * the currently selected endpoint so that it can be restored after another endpoint has been + * manipulated. + * + * \return Index of the currently selected endpoint. + */ + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_GetCurrentEndpoint(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_GetCurrentEndpoint(void) + { + return (USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint | Endpoint_GetEndpointDirection()); + } + + /** Selects the given endpoint address. + * + * Any endpoint operations which do not require the endpoint address to be indicated will operate on + * the currently selected endpoint. + * + * \param[in] Address Endpoint address to select. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(const uint8_t Address) + { + USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint = (Address & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK); + } + + /** Resets the endpoint bank FIFO. This clears all the endpoint banks and resets the USB controller's + * data In and Out pointers to the bank's contents. + * + * \param[in] Address Endpoint number whose FIFO buffers are to be reset. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_ResetEndpoint(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_ResetEndpoint(const uint8_t Address) + { + uint32_t EndpointNumber = (Address & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK); + + AVR32_USBB.uerst |= (AVR32_USBB_EPRST0_MASK << EndpointNumber); + AVR32_USBB.uerst &= ~(AVR32_USBB_EPRST0_MASK << EndpointNumber); + USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[EndpointNumber] = &AVR32_USBB_SLAVE[EndpointNumber * ENDPOINT_HSB_ADDRESS_SPACE_SIZE]; + } + + /** Enables the currently selected endpoint so that data can be sent and received through it to + * and from a host. + * + * \note Endpoints must first be configured properly via \ref Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(). + */ + static inline void Endpoint_EnableEndpoint(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_EnableEndpoint(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.uerst |= (AVR32_USBB_EPEN0_MASK << USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint); + } + + /** Disables the currently selected endpoint so that data cannot be sent and received through it + * to and from a host. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_DisableEndpoint(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_DisableEndpoint(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.uerst &= ~(AVR32_USBB_EPEN0_MASK << USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint); + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected endpoint is enabled, but not necessarily configured. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the currently selected endpoint is enabled, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_IsEnabled(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_IsEnabled(void) + { + return ((AVR32_USBB.uerst & (AVR32_USBB_EPEN0_MASK << USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Retrieves the number of busy banks in the currently selected endpoint, which have been queued for + * transmission via the \ref Endpoint_ClearIN() command, or are awaiting acknowledgement via the + * \ref Endpoint_ClearOUT() command. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_UC3 + * + * \return Total number of busy banks in the selected endpoint. + */ + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_GetBusyBanks(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_GetBusyBanks(void) + { + return (&AVR32_USBB.UESTA0)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].nbusybk; + } + + /** Aborts all pending IN transactions on the currently selected endpoint, once the bank + * has been queued for transmission to the host via \ref Endpoint_ClearIN(). This function + * will terminate all queued transactions, resetting the endpoint banks ready for a new + * packet. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_UC3 + */ + static inline void Endpoint_AbortPendingIN(void) + { + while (Endpoint_GetBusyBanks() != 0) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.UECON0SET)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].killbks = true; + while ((&AVR32_USBB.UECON0)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].killbk); + } + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected endpoint may be read from (if data is waiting in the endpoint + * bank and the endpoint is an OUT direction, or if the bank is not yet full if the endpoint is an IN + * direction). This function will return false if an error has occurred in the endpoint, if the endpoint + * is an OUT direction and no packet (or an empty packet) has been received, or if the endpoint is an IN + * direction and the endpoint bank is full. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_UC3 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the currently selected endpoint may be read from or written to, depending + * on its direction. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed(void) + { + return (&AVR32_USBB.UESTA0)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].rwall; + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected endpoint is configured. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the currently selected endpoint has been configured, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_IsConfigured(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_IsConfigured(void) + { + return (&AVR32_USBB.UESTA0)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].cfgok; + } + + /** Returns a mask indicating which INTERRUPT type endpoints have interrupted - i.e. their + * interrupt duration has elapsed. Which endpoints have interrupted can be determined by + * masking the return value against <tt>(1 << <i>{Endpoint Number}</i>)</tt>. + * + * \return Mask whose bits indicate which endpoints have interrupted. + */ + static inline uint32_t Endpoint_GetEndpointInterrupts(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint32_t Endpoint_GetEndpointInterrupts(void) + { + return ((AVR32_USBB.udint & (AVR32_USBB_EP6INT_MASK | AVR32_USBB_EP5INT_MASK | + AVR32_USBB_EP4INT_MASK | AVR32_USBB_EP3INT_MASK | + AVR32_USBB_EP2INT_MASK | AVR32_USBB_EP1INT_MASK | + AVR32_USBB_EP0INT_MASK)) >> AVR32_USBB_EP0INT_OFFSET); + } + + /** Determines if the specified endpoint number has interrupted (valid only for INTERRUPT type + * endpoints). + * + * \param[in] Address Address of the endpoint whose interrupt flag should be tested. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the specified endpoint has interrupted, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_HasEndpointInterrupted(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_HasEndpointInterrupted(const uint8_t Address) + { + return ((Endpoint_GetEndpointInterrupts() & (AVR32_USBB_EP0INT_MASK << (Address & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK))) ? true : false); + } + + /** Determines if the selected IN endpoint is ready for a new packet to be sent to the host. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_UC3 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the current endpoint is ready for an IN packet, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_IsINReady(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_IsINReady(void) + { + return (&AVR32_USBB.UESTA0)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].txini; + } + + /** Determines if the selected OUT endpoint has received new packet from the host. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_UC3 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if current endpoint is has received an OUT packet, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_IsOUTReceived(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_IsOUTReceived(void) + { + return (&AVR32_USBB.UESTA0)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].rxouti; + } + + /** Determines if the current CONTROL type endpoint has received a SETUP packet. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_UC3 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the selected endpoint has received a SETUP packet, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived(void) + { + return (&AVR32_USBB.UESTA0)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].rxstpi; + } + + /** Clears a received SETUP packet on the currently selected CONTROL type endpoint, freeing up the + * endpoint for the next packet. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_UC3 + * + * \note This is not applicable for non CONTROL type endpoints. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_ClearSETUP(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_ClearSETUP(void) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.UESTA0CLR)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].rxstpic = true; + USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint] = &AVR32_USBB_SLAVE[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint * ENDPOINT_HSB_ADDRESS_SPACE_SIZE]; + } + + /** Sends an IN packet to the host on the currently selected endpoint, freeing up the endpoint for the + * next packet and switching to the alternative endpoint bank if double banked. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_UC3 + */ + static inline void Endpoint_ClearIN(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_ClearIN(void) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.UESTA0CLR)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].txinic = true; + (&AVR32_USBB.UECON0CLR)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].fifoconc = true; + USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint] = &AVR32_USBB_SLAVE[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint * ENDPOINT_HSB_ADDRESS_SPACE_SIZE]; + } + + /** Acknowledges an OUT packet to the host on the currently selected endpoint, freeing up the endpoint + * for the next packet and switching to the alternative endpoint bank if double banked. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_UC3 + */ + static inline void Endpoint_ClearOUT(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_ClearOUT(void) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.UESTA0CLR)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].rxoutic = true; + (&AVR32_USBB.UECON0CLR)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].fifoconc = true; + USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint] = &AVR32_USBB_SLAVE[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint * ENDPOINT_HSB_ADDRESS_SPACE_SIZE]; + } + + /** Stalls the current endpoint, indicating to the host that a logical problem occurred with the + * indicated endpoint and that the current transfer sequence should be aborted. This provides a + * way for devices to indicate invalid commands to the host so that the current transfer can be + * aborted and the host can begin its own recovery sequence. + * + * The currently selected endpoint remains stalled until either the \ref Endpoint_ClearStall() macro + * is called, or the host issues a CLEAR FEATURE request to the device for the currently selected + * endpoint. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_UC3 + */ + static inline void Endpoint_StallTransaction(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_StallTransaction(void) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.UECON0SET)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].stallrqs = true; + } + + /** Clears the STALL condition on the currently selected endpoint. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_UC3 + */ + static inline void Endpoint_ClearStall(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_ClearStall(void) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.UECON0CLR)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].stallrqc = true; + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected endpoint is stalled, \c false otherwise. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_UC3 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the currently selected endpoint is stalled, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_IsStalled(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_IsStalled(void) + { + return (&AVR32_USBB.UECON0)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].stallrq; + } + + /** Resets the data toggle of the currently selected endpoint. */ + static inline void Endpoint_ResetDataToggle(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_ResetDataToggle(void) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.UECON0SET)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].rstdts = true; + } + + /** Sets the direction of the currently selected endpoint. + * + * \param[in] DirectionMask New endpoint direction, as a \c ENDPOINT_DIR_* mask. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(const uint32_t DirectionMask) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(const uint32_t DirectionMask) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.UECFG0)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].epdir = (DirectionMask == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + } + + /** Reads one byte from the currently selected endpoint's bank, for OUT direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \return Next byte in the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_Read_8(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_Read_8(void) + { + return *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + } + + /** Writes one byte to the currently selected endpoint's bank, for IN direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write into the the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Write_8(const uint8_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Write_8(const uint8_t Data) + { + *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++) = Data; + } + + /** Discards one byte from the currently selected endpoint's bank, for OUT direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_UC3 + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Discard_8(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Discard_8(void) + { + uint8_t Dummy; + + Dummy = *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + + (void)Dummy; + } + + /** Reads two bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank in little endian format, for OUT + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \return Next two bytes in the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint16_t Endpoint_Read_16_LE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint16_t Endpoint_Read_16_LE(void) + { + uint16_t Byte0 = *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + uint16_t Byte1 = *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + + return ((Byte1 << 8) | Byte0); + } + + /** Reads two bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank in big endian format, for OUT + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \return Next two bytes in the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint16_t Endpoint_Read_16_BE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint16_t Endpoint_Read_16_BE(void) + { + uint16_t Byte0 = *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + uint16_t Byte1 = *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + + return ((Byte0 << 8) | Byte1); + } + + /** Writes two bytes to the currently selected endpoint's bank in little endian format, for IN + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Write_16_LE(const uint16_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Write_16_LE(const uint16_t Data) + { + *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++) = (Data & 0xFF); + *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++) = (Data >> 8); + } + + /** Writes two bytes to the currently selected endpoint's bank in big endian format, for IN + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Write_16_BE(const uint16_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Write_16_BE(const uint16_t Data) + { + *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++) = (Data >> 8); + *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++) = (Data & 0xFF); + } + + /** Discards two bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank, for OUT direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_UC3 + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Discard_16(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Discard_16(void) + { + uint8_t Dummy; + + Dummy = *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + Dummy = *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + + (void)Dummy; + } + + /** Reads four bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank in little endian format, for OUT + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \return Next four bytes in the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint32_t Endpoint_Read_32_LE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint32_t Endpoint_Read_32_LE(void) + { + uint32_t Byte0 = *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + uint32_t Byte1 = *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + uint32_t Byte2 = *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + uint32_t Byte3 = *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + + return ((Byte3 << 24) | (Byte2 << 16) | (Byte1 << 8) | Byte0); + } + + /** Reads four bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank in big endian format, for OUT + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \return Next four bytes in the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint32_t Endpoint_Read_32_BE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint32_t Endpoint_Read_32_BE(void) + { + uint32_t Byte0 = *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + uint32_t Byte1 = *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + uint32_t Byte2 = *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + uint32_t Byte3 = *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + + return ((Byte0 << 24) | (Byte1 << 16) | (Byte2 << 8) | Byte3); + } + + /** Writes four bytes to the currently selected endpoint's bank in little endian format, for IN + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Write_32_LE(const uint32_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Write_32_LE(const uint32_t Data) + { + *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++) = (Data & 0xFF); + *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++) = (Data >> 8); + *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++) = (Data >> 16); + *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++) = (Data >> 24); + } + + /** Writes four bytes to the currently selected endpoint's bank in big endian format, for IN + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Write_32_BE(const uint32_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Write_32_BE(const uint32_t Data) + { + *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++) = (Data >> 24); + *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++) = (Data >> 16); + *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++) = (Data >> 8); + *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++) = (Data & 0xFF); + } + + /** Discards four bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank, for OUT direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_UC3 + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Discard_32(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Discard_32(void) + { + uint8_t Dummy; + + Dummy = *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + Dummy = *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + Dummy = *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + Dummy = *(USB_Endpoint_FIFOPos[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint]++); + + (void)Dummy; + } + + /* External Variables: */ + /** Global indicating the maximum packet size of the default control endpoint located at address + * 0 in the device. This value is set to the value indicated in the device descriptor in the user + * project once the USB interface is initialized into device mode. + * + * If space is an issue, it is possible to fix this to a static value by defining the control + * endpoint size in the \c FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE token passed to the compiler in the makefile + * via the -D switch. When a fixed control endpoint size is used, the size is no longer dynamically + * read from the descriptors at runtime and instead fixed to the given value. When used, it is + * important that the descriptor control endpoint size value matches the size given as the + * \c FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE token - it is recommended that the \c FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE token + * be used in the device descriptors to ensure this. + * + * \attention This variable should be treated as read-only in the user application, and never manually + * changed in value. + */ + #if (!defined(FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + extern uint8_t USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize; + #else + #define USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE + #endif + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Configures a table of endpoint descriptions, in sequence. This function can be used to configure multiple + * endpoints at the same time. + * + * \note Endpoints with a zero address will be ignored, thus this function cannot be used to configure the + * control endpoint. + * + * \param[in] Table Pointer to a table of endpoint descriptions. + * \param[in] Entries Number of entries in the endpoint table to configure. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if all endpoints configured successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(const USB_Endpoint_Table_t* const Table, + const uint8_t Entries); + + /** Completes the status stage of a control transfer on a CONTROL type endpoint automatically, + * with respect to the data direction. This is a convenience function which can be used to + * simplify user control request handling. + * + * \note This routine should not be called on non CONTROL type endpoints. + */ + void Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(void); + + /** Spin-loops until the currently selected non-control endpoint is ready for the next packet of data + * to be read or written to it. + * + * \note This routine should not be called on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointRW_UC3 + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(void); + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Host_UC3.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Host_UC3.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2c182ab69c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Host_UC3.c @@ -0,0 +1,297 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_HOST_C +#include "../Host.h" + +void USB_Host_ProcessNextHostState(void) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode = HOST_ENUMERROR_NoError; + uint8_t SubErrorCode = HOST_ENUMERROR_NoError; + + static uint16_t WaitMSRemaining; + static uint8_t PostWaitState; + + switch (USB_HostState) + { + case HOST_STATE_WaitForDevice: + if (WaitMSRemaining) + { + if ((SubErrorCode = USB_Host_WaitMS(1)) != HOST_WAITERROR_Successful) + { + USB_HostState = PostWaitState; + ErrorCode = HOST_ENUMERROR_WaitStage; + break; + } + + if (!(--WaitMSRemaining)) + USB_HostState = PostWaitState; + } + + break; + case HOST_STATE_Powered: + WaitMSRemaining = HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS; + + USB_HostState = HOST_STATE_Powered_WaitForDeviceSettle; + break; + case HOST_STATE_Powered_WaitForDeviceSettle: + if (WaitMSRemaining--) + { + Delay_MS(1); + break; + } + else + { + USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_Off(); + + USB_OTGPAD_On(); + USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_Enable(); + USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_On(); + + #if defined(NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT) + USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_Enable(); + USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_On(); + #endif + + USB_HostState = HOST_STATE_Powered_WaitForConnect; + } + + break; + case HOST_STATE_Powered_WaitForConnect: + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_DCONNI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_DCONNI); + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_DDISCI); + + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_VBERRI); + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_VBERRI); + + USB_Host_ResumeBus(); + Pipe_ClearPipes(); + + HOST_TASK_NONBLOCK_WAIT(100, HOST_STATE_Powered_DoReset); + } + + break; + case HOST_STATE_Powered_DoReset: + USB_Host_ResetDevice(); + + HOST_TASK_NONBLOCK_WAIT(200, HOST_STATE_Powered_ConfigPipe); + break; + case HOST_STATE_Powered_ConfigPipe: + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE, EP_TYPE_CONTROL, ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP, PIPE_CONTROLPIPE_DEFAULT_SIZE, 1))) + { + ErrorCode = HOST_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigError; + SubErrorCode = 0; + break; + } + + USB_HostState = HOST_STATE_Default; + break; + case HOST_STATE_Default: + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_DEVICE), + .bRequest = REQ_GetDescriptor, + .wValue = (DTYPE_Device << 8), + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = 8, + }; + + uint8_t DataBuffer[8]; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + if ((SubErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(DataBuffer)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + ErrorCode = HOST_ENUMERROR_ControlError; + break; + } + + USB_Host_ControlPipeSize = DataBuffer[offsetof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t, Endpoint0Size)]; + + USB_Host_ResetDevice(); + + HOST_TASK_NONBLOCK_WAIT(200, HOST_STATE_Default_PostReset); + break; + case HOST_STATE_Default_PostReset: + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE, EP_TYPE_CONTROL, ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP, USB_Host_ControlPipeSize, 1))) + { + ErrorCode = HOST_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigError; + SubErrorCode = 0; + break; + } + + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_DEVICE), + .bRequest = REQ_SetAddress, + .wValue = USB_HOST_DEVICEADDRESS, + .wIndex = 0, + .wLength = 0, + }; + + if ((SubErrorCode = USB_Host_SendControlRequest(NULL)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + ErrorCode = HOST_ENUMERROR_ControlError; + break; + } + + HOST_TASK_NONBLOCK_WAIT(100, HOST_STATE_Default_PostAddressSet); + break; + case HOST_STATE_Default_PostAddressSet: + USB_Host_SetDeviceAddress(USB_HOST_DEVICEADDRESS); + + USB_HostState = HOST_STATE_Addressed; + + EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(); + break; + + default: + break; + } + + if ((ErrorCode != HOST_ENUMERROR_NoError) && (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Unattached)) + { + EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(ErrorCode, SubErrorCode); + + USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_Off(); + + EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(); + + USB_ResetInterface(); + } +} + +uint8_t USB_Host_WaitMS(uint8_t MS) +{ + bool BusSuspended = USB_Host_IsBusSuspended(); + uint8_t ErrorCode = HOST_WAITERROR_Successful; + bool HSOFIEnabled = USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_HSOFI); + + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_HSOFI); + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_HSOFI); + + USB_Host_ResumeBus(); + + while (MS) + { + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_HSOFI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_HSOFI); + MS--; + } + + if ((USB_HostState == HOST_STATE_Unattached) || (USB_CurrentMode != USB_MODE_Host)) + { + ErrorCode = HOST_WAITERROR_DeviceDisconnect; + + break; + } + + if (Pipe_IsError()) + { + Pipe_ClearError(); + ErrorCode = HOST_WAITERROR_PipeError; + + break; + } + + if (Pipe_IsStalled()) + { + Pipe_ClearStall(); + ErrorCode = HOST_WAITERROR_SetupStalled; + + break; + } + } + + if (BusSuspended) + USB_Host_SuspendBus(); + + if (HSOFIEnabled) + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_HSOFI); + + return ErrorCode; +} + +static void USB_Host_ResetDevice(void) +{ + bool BusSuspended = USB_Host_IsBusSuspended(); + + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_DDISCI); + + USB_Host_ResetBus(); + while (!(USB_Host_IsBusResetComplete())); + USB_Host_ResumeBus(); + + USB_Host_ConfigurationNumber = 0; + + bool HSOFIEnabled = USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_HSOFI); + + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_HSOFI); + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_HSOFI); + + for (uint8_t MSRem = 10; MSRem != 0; MSRem--) + { + /* Workaround for powerless-pull-up devices. After a USB bus reset, + all disconnection interrupts are suppressed while a USB frame is + looked for - if it is found within 10ms, the device is still + present. */ + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_HSOFI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_HSOFI); + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_DDISCI); + break; + } + + Delay_MS(1); + } + + if (HSOFIEnabled) + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_HSOFI); + + if (BusSuspended) + USB_Host_SuspendBus(); + + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_DDISCI); +} + +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Host_UC3.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Host_UC3.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5338f72089 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Host_UC3.h @@ -0,0 +1,363 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Host definitions for the AVR32 UC3B microcontrollers. + * \copydetails Group_Host_UC3B + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Host + * \defgroup Group_Host_UC3B Host Management (UC3B) + * \brief USB Host definitions for the AVR32 UC3B microcontrollers. + * + * Architecture specific USB Host definitions for the Atmel 32-bit AVR UC3B microcontrollers. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __USBHOST_UC3B_H__ +#define __USBHOST_UC3B_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../StdDescriptors.h" + #include "../Pipe.h" + #include "../USBInterrupt.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Indicates the fixed USB device address which any attached device is enumerated to when in + * host mode. As only one USB device may be attached to the AVR in host mode at any one time + * and that the address used is not important (other than the fact that it is non-zero), a + * fixed value is specified by the library. + */ + #define USB_HOST_DEVICEADDRESS 1 + + #if !defined(HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Constant for the delay in milliseconds after a device is connected before the library + * will start the enumeration process. Some devices require a delay of up to 5 seconds + * after connection before the enumeration process can start or incorrect operation will + * occur. + * + * The default delay value may be overridden in the user project makefile by defining the + * \c HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS token to the required delay in milliseconds, and passed to the + * compiler using the -D switch. + */ + #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS 1000 + #endif + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the error codes for the \ref EVENT_USB_Host_HostError() event. + * + * \see \ref Group_Events for more information on this event. + */ + enum USB_Host_ErrorCodes_t + { + HOST_ERROR_VBusVoltageDip = 0, /**< VBUS voltage dipped to an unacceptable level. This + * error may be the result of an attached device drawing + * too much current from the VBUS line, or due to the + * AVR's power source being unable to supply sufficient + * current. + */ + }; + + /** Enum for the error codes for the \ref EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed() event. + * + * \see \ref Group_Events for more information on this event. + */ + enum USB_Host_EnumerationErrorCodes_t + { + HOST_ENUMERROR_NoError = 0, /**< No error occurred. Used internally, this is not a valid + * ErrorCode parameter value for the \ref EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed() + * event. + */ + HOST_ENUMERROR_WaitStage = 1, /**< One of the delays between enumeration steps failed + * to complete successfully, due to a timeout or other + * error. + */ + HOST_ENUMERROR_NoDeviceDetected = 2, /**< No device was detected, despite the USB data lines + * indicating the attachment of a device. + */ + HOST_ENUMERROR_ControlError = 3, /**< One of the enumeration control requests failed to + * complete successfully. + */ + HOST_ENUMERROR_PipeConfigError = 4, /**< The default control pipe (address 0) failed to + * configure correctly. + */ + }; + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Returns the current USB frame number, when in host mode. Every millisecond the USB bus is active (i.e. not suspended) + * the frame number is incremented by one. + * + * \return Current USB frame number from the USB controller. + */ + static inline uint16_t USB_Host_GetFrameNumber(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint16_t USB_Host_GetFrameNumber(void) + { + return AVR32_USBB_UHFNUM; + } + + #if !defined(NO_SOF_EVENTS) + /** Enables the host mode Start Of Frame events. When enabled, this causes the + * \ref EVENT_USB_Host_StartOfFrame() event to fire once per millisecond, synchronized to the USB bus, + * at the start of each USB frame when a device is enumerated while in host mode. + * + * \note This function is not available when the \c NO_SOF_EVENTS compile time token is defined. + */ + static inline void USB_Host_EnableSOFEvents(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_EnableSOFEvents(void) + { + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_HSOFI); + } + + /** Disables the host mode Start Of Frame events. When disabled, this stops the firing of the + * \ref EVENT_USB_Host_StartOfFrame() event when enumerated in host mode. + * + * \note This function is not available when the \c NO_SOF_EVENTS compile time token is defined. + */ + static inline void USB_Host_DisableSOFEvents(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_DisableSOFEvents(void) + { + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_HSOFI); + } + #endif + + /** Resets the USB bus, including the endpoints in any attached device and pipes on the AVR host. + * USB bus resets leave the default control pipe configured (if already configured). + * + * If the USB bus has been suspended prior to issuing a bus reset, the attached device will be + * woken up automatically and the bus resumed after the reset has been correctly issued. + */ + static inline void USB_Host_ResetBus(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_ResetBus(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.UHCON.reset = true; + } + + /** Determines if a previously issued bus reset (via the \ref USB_Host_ResetBus() macro) has + * completed. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if no bus reset is currently being sent, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool USB_Host_IsBusResetComplete(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool USB_Host_IsBusResetComplete(void) + { + return AVR32_USBB.UHCON.reset; + } + + /** Resumes USB communications with an attached and enumerated device, by resuming the transmission + * of the 1MS Start Of Frame messages to the device. When resumed, USB communications between the + * host and attached device may occur. + */ + static inline void USB_Host_ResumeBus(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_ResumeBus(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.UHCON.sofe = true; + } + + /** Suspends the USB bus, preventing any communications from occurring between the host and attached + * device until the bus has been resumed. This stops the transmission of the 1MS Start Of Frame + * messages to the device. + * + * \note While the USB bus is suspended, all USB interrupt sources are also disabled; this means that + * some events (such as device disconnections) will not fire until the bus is resumed. + */ + static inline void USB_Host_SuspendBus(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_SuspendBus(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.UHCON.sofe = false; + } + + /** Determines if the USB bus has been suspended via the use of the \ref USB_Host_SuspendBus() macro, + * false otherwise. While suspended, no USB communications can occur until the bus is resumed, + * except for the Remote Wakeup event from the device if supported. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the bus is currently suspended, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool USB_Host_IsBusSuspended(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool USB_Host_IsBusSuspended(void) + { + return AVR32_USBB.UHCON.sofe; + } + + /** Determines if the attached device is currently enumerated in Full Speed mode (12Mb/s), or + * false if the attached device is enumerated in Low Speed mode (1.5Mb/s). + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the attached device is enumerated in Full Speed mode, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool USB_Host_IsDeviceFullSpeed(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool USB_Host_IsDeviceFullSpeed(void) + { + return (AVR32_USBB.USBSTA.speed == AVR32_USBB_SPEED_FULL); + } + + /** Determines if the attached device is currently issuing a Remote Wakeup request, requesting + * that the host resume the USB bus and wake up the device, \c false otherwise. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the attached device has sent a Remote Wakeup request, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool USB_Host_IsRemoteWakeupSent(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool USB_Host_IsRemoteWakeupSent(void) + { + return AVR32_USBB.UHINT.rxrsmi; + } + + /** Clears the flag indicating that a Remote Wakeup request has been issued by an attached device. */ + static inline void USB_Host_ClearRemoteWakeupSent(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_ClearRemoteWakeupSent(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.UHINTCLR.rxrsmic = true; + } + + /** Accepts a Remote Wakeup request from an attached device. This must be issued in response to + * a device's Remote Wakeup request within 2ms for the request to be accepted and the bus to + * be resumed. + */ + static inline void USB_Host_ResumeFromWakeupRequest(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_ResumeFromWakeupRequest(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.UHCON.resume = true; + } + + /** Determines if a resume from Remote Wakeup request is currently being sent to an attached + * device. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if no resume request is currently being sent, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool USB_Host_IsResumeFromWakeupRequestSent(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool USB_Host_IsResumeFromWakeupRequestSent(void) + { + return AVR32_USBB.UHCON.resume; + } + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + static inline void USB_Host_HostMode_On(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_HostMode_On(void) + { + // Not required for UC3B + } + + static inline void USB_Host_HostMode_Off(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_HostMode_Off(void) + { + // Not required for UC3B + } + + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_Enable(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_Enable(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.vbushwc = false; + } + + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_Enable(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_Enable(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.vbushwc = true; + } + + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_On(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_On(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.USBSTASET.vbusrqs = true; + } + + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_On(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_On(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.USBSTASET.vbusrqs = true; + } + + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_Off(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_Off(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.USBSTACLR.vbusrqc = true; + } + + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_Off(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_Off(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.USBSTACLR.vbusrqc = true; + } + + static inline void USB_Host_SetDeviceAddress(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Host_SetDeviceAddress(const uint8_t Address) + { + AVR32_USBB.UHADDR1.uhaddr_p0 = Address; + AVR32_USBB.UHADDR1.uhaddr_p1 = Address; + AVR32_USBB.UHADDR1.uhaddr_p2 = Address; + AVR32_USBB.UHADDR1.uhaddr_p3 = Address; + AVR32_USBB.UHADDR2.uhaddr_p4 = Address; + AVR32_USBB.UHADDR2.uhaddr_p5 = Address; + AVR32_USBB.UHADDR2.uhaddr_p6 = Address; + } + + /* Enums: */ + enum USB_Host_WaitMSErrorCodes_t + { + HOST_WAITERROR_Successful = 0, + HOST_WAITERROR_DeviceDisconnect = 1, + HOST_WAITERROR_PipeError = 2, + HOST_WAITERROR_SetupStalled = 3, + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void USB_Host_ProcessNextHostState(void); + uint8_t USB_Host_WaitMS(uint8_t MS); + + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_HOST_C) + static void USB_Host_ResetDevice(void); + #endif + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/PipeStream_UC3.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/PipeStream_UC3.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..27426ada0b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/PipeStream_UC3.c @@ -0,0 +1,166 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + +#include "PipeStream_UC3.h" + +uint8_t Pipe_Discard_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + uint16_t BytesInTransfer = 0; + + Pipe_SetPipeToken(PIPE_TOKEN_IN); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + Length -= *BytesProcessed; + + while (Length) + { + if (!(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Pipe_ClearIN(); + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + *BytesProcessed += BytesInTransfer; + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + } + else + { + Pipe_Discard_8(); + + Length--; + BytesInTransfer++; + } + } + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +uint8_t Pipe_Null_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + uint16_t BytesInTransfer = 0; + + Pipe_SetPipeToken(PIPE_TOKEN_OUT); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + Length -= *BytesProcessed; + + while (Length) + { + if (!(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + *BytesProcessed += BytesInTransfer; + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer; + } + + USB_USBTask(); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + } + else + { + Pipe_Write_8(0); + + Length--; + BytesInTransfer++; + } + } + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +/* The following abuses the C preprocessor in order to copy-paste common code with slight alterations, + * so that the code needs to be written once. It is a crude form of templating to reduce code maintenance. */ + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Pipe_Write_Stream_LE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* +#define TEMPLATE_TOKEN PIPE_TOKEN_OUT +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_PIPE() Pipe_ClearOUT() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) DataStream += Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Pipe_Write_8(*BufferPtr) +#include "Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Pipe_Write_Stream_BE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* +#define TEMPLATE_TOKEN PIPE_TOKEN_OUT +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_PIPE() Pipe_ClearOUT() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) DataStream -= Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Pipe_Write_8(*BufferPtr) +#include "Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Pipe_Read_Stream_LE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE void* +#define TEMPLATE_TOKEN PIPE_TOKEN_IN +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_PIPE() Pipe_ClearIN() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) DataStream += Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) *BufferPtr = Pipe_Read_8() +#include "Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Pipe_Read_Stream_BE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE void* +#define TEMPLATE_TOKEN PIPE_TOKEN_IN +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_PIPE() Pipe_ClearIN() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) DataStream -= Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) *BufferPtr = Pipe_Read_8() +#include "Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c" + +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/PipeStream_UC3.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/PipeStream_UC3.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cc34442084 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/PipeStream_UC3.h @@ -0,0 +1,352 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Pipe data stream transmission and reception management for the AVR32 UC3 microcontrollers. + * \copydetails Group_PipeStreamRW_UC3 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PipeStreamRW + * \defgroup Group_PipeStreamRW_UC3 Read/Write of Multi-Byte Streams (UC3) + * \brief Pipe data stream transmission and reception management for the Atmel AVR32 UC3 architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing of data streams from + * and to pipes. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __PIPE_STREAM_UC3_H__ +#define __PIPE_STREAM_UC3_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../USBMode.h" + #include "../USBTask.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** \name Stream functions for null data */ + //@{ + + /** Reads and discards the given number of bytes from the pipe, discarding fully read packets from the host + * as needed. The last packet is not automatically discarded once the remaining bytes has been read; the + * user is responsible for manually discarding the last packet from the device via the \ref Pipe_ClearIN() macro. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, failing or + * succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid storage location, the transfer + * will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time the pipe bank becomes empty while there is still data + * to process (and after the current packet has been acknowledged) the BytesProcessed location will be updated with + * the total number of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed in the user code - to + * continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters and it will resume until the BytesProcessed + * value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Discard_Stream(512, NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Discard_Stream(512, &BytesProcessed)) == PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note The pipe token is set automatically, thus this can be used on bi-directional pipes directly without + * having to explicitly change the data direction with a call to \ref Pipe_SetPipeToken(). + * + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to discard via the currently selected pipe. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes already processed should + * updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be processed at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_Discard_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed); + + /** Writes a given number of zeroed bytes to the pipe, sending full pipe packets from the host to the device + * as needed. The last packet is not automatically sent once the remaining bytes has been written; the + * user is responsible for manually discarding the last packet from the device via the \ref Pipe_ClearOUT() macro. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, failing or + * succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid storage location, the transfer + * will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time the pipe bank becomes full while there is still data + * to process (and after the current packet transmission has been initiated) the BytesProcessed location will be + * updated with the total number of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed in the user code - to + * continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters and it will resume until the BytesProcessed + * value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Null_Stream(512, NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Null_Stream(512, &BytesProcessed)) == PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note The pipe token is set automatically, thus this can be used on bi-directional pipes directly without + * having to explicitly change the data direction with a call to \ref Pipe_SetPipeToken(). + * + * \param[in] Length Number of zero bytes to write via the currently selected pipe. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes already processed should + * updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be processed at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_Null_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed); + + //@} + + /** \name Stream functions for RAM source/destination data */ + //@{ + + /** Writes the given number of bytes to the pipe from the given buffer in little endian, + * sending full packets to the device as needed. The last packet filled is not automatically sent; + * the user is responsible for manually sending the last written packet to the host via the + * \ref Pipe_ClearOUT() macro. Between each USB packet, the given stream callback function is + * executed repeatedly until the next packet is ready, allowing for early aborts of stream transfers. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, + * failing or succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid + * storage location, the transfer will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time + * the pipe bank becomes full while there is still data to process (and after the current + * packet transmission has been initiated) the BytesProcessed location will be updated with the + * total number of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed + * in the user code - to continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters + * and it will resume until the BytesProcessed value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * &BytesProcessed)) == PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note The pipe token is set automatically, thus this can be used on bi-directional pipes directly without + * having to explicitly change the data direction with a call to \ref Pipe_SetPipeToken(). + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected pipe into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes already processed should + * updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Writes the given number of bytes to the pipe from the given buffer in big endian, + * sending full packets to the device as needed. The last packet filled is not automatically sent; + * the user is responsible for manually sending the last written packet to the host via the + * \ref Pipe_ClearOUT() macro. Between each USB packet, the given stream callback function is + * executed repeatedly until the next packet is ready, allowing for early aborts of stream transfers. + * + * \note The pipe token is set automatically, thus this can be used on bi-directional pipes directly without + * having to explicitly change the data direction with a call to \ref Pipe_SetPipeToken(). + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected pipe into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes already processed should + * updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_Write_Stream_BE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads the given number of bytes from the pipe into the given buffer in little endian, + * sending full packets to the device as needed. The last packet filled is not automatically sent; + * the user is responsible for manually sending the last written packet to the host via the + * \ref Pipe_ClearIN() macro. Between each USB packet, the given stream callback function is + * executed repeatedly until the next packet is ready, allowing for early aborts of stream transfers. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, + * failing or succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid + * storage location, the transfer will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time + * the pipe bank becomes empty while there is still data to process (and after the current + * packet has been acknowledged) the BytesProcessed location will be updated with the total number + * of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed + * in the user code - to continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters + * and it will resume until the BytesProcessed value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * NULL)) != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * &BytesProcessed)) == PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note The pipe token is set automatically, thus this can be used on bi-directional pipes directly without + * having to explicitly change the data direction with a call to \ref Pipe_SetPipeToken(). + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected pipe to read from. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes already processed should + * updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_Read_Stream_LE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads the given number of bytes from the pipe into the given buffer in big endian, + * sending full packets to the device as needed. The last packet filled is not automatically sent; + * the user is responsible for manually sending the last written packet to the host via the + * \ref Pipe_ClearIN() macro. Between each USB packet, the given stream callback function is + * executed repeatedly until the next packet is ready, allowing for early aborts of stream transfers. + * + * \note The pipe token is set automatically, thus this can be used on bi-directional pipes directly without + * having to explicitly change the data direction with a call to \ref Pipe_SetPipeToken(). + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected pipe to read from. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes already processed should + * updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_Read_Stream_BE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + //@} + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Pipe_UC3.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Pipe_UC3.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..73cf360783 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Pipe_UC3.c @@ -0,0 +1,209 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + +#include "../Pipe.h" + +uint8_t USB_Host_ControlPipeSize = PIPE_CONTROLPIPE_DEFAULT_SIZE; + +volatile uint32_t USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe = PIPE_CONTROLPIPE; +volatile uint8_t* USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[PIPE_TOTAL_PIPES]; + +bool Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(const USB_Pipe_Table_t* const Table, + const uint8_t Entries) +{ + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < Entries; i++) + { + if (!(Table[i].Address)) + continue; + + if (!(Pipe_ConfigurePipe(Table[i].Address, Table[i].Type, Table[i].EndpointAddress, Table[i].Size, Table[i].Banks))) + { + return false; + } + } + + return true; +} + +bool Pipe_ConfigurePipe(const uint8_t Address, + const uint8_t Type, + const uint8_t EndpointAddress, + const uint16_t Size, + const uint8_t Banks) +{ + uint8_t Number = (Address & PIPE_EPNUM_MASK); + uint8_t Token = (Address & PIPE_DIR_IN) ? PIPE_TOKEN_IN : PIPE_TOKEN_OUT; + + if (Number >= PIPE_TOTAL_PIPES) + return false; + + if (Type == EP_TYPE_CONTROL) + Token = PIPE_TOKEN_SETUP; + + USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[Number] = &AVR32_USBB_SLAVE[Number * PIPE_HSB_ADDRESS_SPACE_SIZE]; + +#if defined(ORDERED_EP_CONFIG) + Pipe_SelectPipe(Number); + Pipe_EnablePipe(); + + (&AVR32_USBB.upcfg0)[Number] = 0; + (&AVR32_USBB.upcfg0)[Number] = (AVR32_USBB_ALLOC_MASK | + ((uint32_t)Type << AVR32_USBB_PTYPE_OFFSET) | + ((uint32_t)Token << AVR32_USBB_PTOKEN_OFFSET) | + ((Banks > 1) ? AVR32_USBB_PBK_MASK : 0) | + Pipe_BytesToEPSizeMask(Size) | + ((uint32_t)Number << AVR32_USBB_PEPNUM_OFFSET)); + + Pipe_SetInfiniteINRequests(); + + return Pipe_IsConfigured(); +#else + for (uint8_t PNum = Number; PNum < PIPE_TOTAL_PIPES; PNum++) + { + uint32_t UPCFG0Temp; + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PNum); + + if (PNum == Number) + { + UPCFG0Temp = (AVR32_USBB_ALLOC_MASK | + ((uint32_t)Type << AVR32_USBB_PTYPE_OFFSET) | + ((uint32_t)Token << AVR32_USBB_PTOKEN_OFFSET) | + ((Banks > 1) ? AVR32_USBB_PBK_MASK : 0) | + Pipe_BytesToEPSizeMask(Size) | + ((EndpointAddress & PIPE_EPNUM_MASK) << AVR32_USBB_PEPNUM_OFFSET)); + } + else + { + UPCFG0Temp = (&AVR32_USBB.upcfg0)[PNum]; + } + + if (!(UPCFG0Temp & AVR32_USBB_ALLOC_MASK)) + continue; + + Pipe_DisablePipe(); + (&AVR32_USBB.upcfg0)[PNum] &= ~AVR32_USBB_ALLOC_MASK; + + Pipe_EnablePipe(); + (&AVR32_USBB.upcfg0)[PNum] = UPCFG0Temp; + + Pipe_SetInfiniteINRequests(); + + if (!(Pipe_IsConfigured())) + return false; + } + + Pipe_SelectPipe(Number); + return true; +#endif +} + +void Pipe_ClearPipes(void) +{ + for (uint8_t PNum = 0; PNum < PIPE_TOTAL_PIPES; PNum++) + { + Pipe_SelectPipe(PNum); + (&AVR32_USBB.upcfg0)[PNum] = 0; + (&AVR32_USBB.upcon0clr)[PNum] = -1; + USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[PNum] = &AVR32_USBB_SLAVE[PNum * 0x10000]; + Pipe_DisablePipe(); + } +} + +bool Pipe_IsEndpointBound(const uint8_t EndpointAddress) +{ + uint8_t PrevPipeNumber = Pipe_GetCurrentPipe(); + + for (uint8_t PNum = 0; PNum < PIPE_TOTAL_PIPES; PNum++) + { + Pipe_SelectPipe(PNum); + + if (!(Pipe_IsConfigured())) + continue; + + if (Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress() == EndpointAddress) + return true; + } + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PrevPipeNumber); + return false; +} + +uint8_t Pipe_WaitUntilReady(void) +{ + #if (USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS < 0xFF) + uint8_t TimeoutMSRem = USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS; + #else + uint16_t TimeoutMSRem = USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS; + #endif + + uint16_t PreviousFrameNumber = USB_Host_GetFrameNumber(); + + for (;;) + { + if (Pipe_GetPipeToken() == PIPE_TOKEN_IN) + { + if (Pipe_IsINReceived()) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError; + } + else + { + if (Pipe_IsOUTReady()) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError; + } + + if (Pipe_IsStalled()) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_PipeStalled; + else if (USB_HostState == HOST_STATE_Unattached) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + + uint16_t CurrentFrameNumber = USB_Host_GetFrameNumber(); + + if (CurrentFrameNumber != PreviousFrameNumber) + { + PreviousFrameNumber = CurrentFrameNumber; + + if (!(TimeoutMSRem--)) + return PIPE_READYWAIT_Timeout; + } + } +} + +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Pipe_UC3.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Pipe_UC3.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..12e0dcd62d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Pipe_UC3.h @@ -0,0 +1,924 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Pipe definitions for the AVR32 UC3 microcontrollers. + * \copydetails Group_PipeManagement_UC3 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PipeRW + * \defgroup Group_PipeRW_UC3 Pipe Data Reading and Writing (UC3) + * \brief Pipe data read/write definitions for the Atmel AVR32 UC3 architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing from and to pipes. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW + * \defgroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_UC3 Read/Write of Primitive Data Types (UC3) + * \brief Pipe primitive data read/write definitions for the Atmel AVR32 UC3 architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing of primitive data types + * from and to pipes. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement + * \defgroup Group_PipePacketManagement_UC3 Pipe Packet Management (UC3) + * \brief Pipe packet management definitions for the Atmel AVR32 UC3 architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to packet management of pipes. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PipeControlReq + * \defgroup Group_PipeControlReq_UC3 Pipe Control Request Management (UC3) + * \brief Pipe control request management definitions for the Atmel AVR32 UC3 architecture. + * + * Module for host mode request processing. This module allows for the transmission of standard, class and + * vendor control requests to the default control endpoint of an attached device while in host mode. + * + * \see Chapter 9 of the USB 2.0 specification. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PipeManagement + * \defgroup Group_PipeManagement_UC3 Pipe Management (UC3) + * \brief Pipe management definitions for the Atmel AVR32 UC3 architecture. + * + * This module contains functions, macros and enums related to pipe management when in USB Host mode. This + * module contains the pipe management macros, as well as pipe interrupt and data send/receive functions + * for various data types. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __PIPE_UC3_H__ +#define __PIPE_UC3_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../USBTask.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #define PIPE_HSB_ADDRESS_SPACE_SIZE (64 * 1024UL) + + /* External Variables: */ + extern volatile uint32_t USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe; + extern volatile uint8_t* USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[]; + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** \name Pipe Error Flag Masks */ + //@{ + /** Mask for \ref Pipe_GetErrorFlags(), indicating that an overflow error occurred in the pipe on the received data. */ + #define PIPE_ERRORFLAG_OVERFLOW (AVR32_USBB_UPSTA0_OVERFI_MASK << 8) + + /** Mask for \ref Pipe_GetErrorFlags(), indicating that a CRC error occurred in the pipe on the received data. */ + #define PIPE_ERRORFLAG_CRC16 AVR32_USBB_UPERR0_CRC16_MASK + + /** Mask for \ref Pipe_GetErrorFlags(), indicating that a hardware timeout error occurred in the pipe. */ + #define PIPE_ERRORFLAG_TIMEOUT AVR32_USBB_UPERR0_TIMEOUT_MASK + + /** Mask for \ref Pipe_GetErrorFlags(), indicating that a hardware PID error occurred in the pipe. */ + #define PIPE_ERRORFLAG_PID AVR32_USBB_UPERR0_PID_MASK + + /** Mask for \ref Pipe_GetErrorFlags(), indicating that a hardware data PID error occurred in the pipe. */ + #define PIPE_ERRORFLAG_DATAPID AVR32_USBB_UPERR0_DATAPID_MASK + + /** Mask for \ref Pipe_GetErrorFlags(), indicating that a hardware data toggle error occurred in the pipe. */ + #define PIPE_ERRORFLAG_DATATGL AVR32_USBB_UPERR0_DATATGL_MASK + //@} + + /** \name Pipe Token Masks */ + //@{ + /** Token mask for \ref Pipe_SetPipeToken() and \ref Pipe_GetPipeToken(). This sets the pipe as a SETUP token (for CONTROL type pipes), + * which will trigger a control request on the attached device when data is written to the pipe. + */ + #define PIPE_TOKEN_SETUP AVR32_USBB_UPCFG0_PTOKEN_SETUP + + /** Token mask for \ref Pipe_SetPipeToken() and \ref Pipe_GetPipeToken(). This sets the pipe as a IN token (for non-CONTROL type pipes), + * indicating that the pipe data will flow from device to host. + */ + #define PIPE_TOKEN_IN AVR32_USBB_UPCFG0_PTOKEN_IN + + /** Token mask for \ref Pipe_SetPipeToken() and \ref Pipe_GetPipeToken(). This sets the pipe as a OUT token (for non-CONTROL type pipes), + * indicating that the pipe data will flow from host to device. + */ + #define PIPE_TOKEN_OUT AVR32_USBB_UPCFG0_PTOKEN_OUT + //@} + + /** Default size of the default control pipe's bank, until altered by the Endpoint0Size value + * in the device descriptor of the attached device. + */ + #define PIPE_CONTROLPIPE_DEFAULT_SIZE 64 + + #if defined(USB_SERIES_UC3A3_AVR32) || defined(USB_SERIES_UC3A4_AVR32) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Total number of pipes (including the default control pipe at address 0) which may be used in + * the device. + */ + #define PIPE_TOTAL_PIPES 8 + #else + #define PIPE_TOTAL_PIPES 7 + #endif + + /** Size in bytes of the largest pipe bank size possible in the device. Not all banks on each AVR + * model supports the largest bank size possible on the device; different pipe numbers support + * different maximum bank sizes. This value reflects the largest possible bank of any pipe on the + * currently selected UC3 AVR model. + */ + #define PIPE_MAX_SIZE 256 + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible error return codes of the \ref Pipe_WaitUntilReady() function. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipeRW_UC3 + */ + enum Pipe_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t + { + PIPE_READYWAIT_NoError = 0, /**< Pipe ready for next packet, no error. */ + PIPE_READYWAIT_PipeStalled = 1, /**< The device stalled the pipe while waiting. */ + PIPE_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected = 2, /**< Device was disconnected from the host while waiting. */ + PIPE_READYWAIT_Timeout = 3, /**< The device failed to accept or send the next packet + * within the software timeout period set by the + * \ref USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS macro. + */ + }; + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Indicates the number of bytes currently stored in the current pipes's selected bank. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipeRW_UC3 + * + * \return Total number of bytes in the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint16_t Pipe_BytesInPipe(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint16_t Pipe_BytesInPipe(void) + { + return (&AVR32_USBB.UPSTA0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].pbyct; + } + + /** Determines the currently selected pipe's direction. + * + * \return The currently selected pipe's direction, as a \c PIPE_DIR_* mask. + */ + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetPipeDirection(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetPipeDirection(void) + { + return (((&AVR32_USBB.UPCFG0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].ptoken == PIPE_TOKEN_OUT) ? PIPE_DIR_OUT : PIPE_DIR_IN); + } + + /** Returns the pipe address of the currently selected pipe. This is typically used to save the + * currently selected pipe number so that it can be restored after another pipe has been manipulated. + * + * \return Index of the currently selected pipe. + */ + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetCurrentPipe(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetCurrentPipe(void) + { + return (USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe | Pipe_GetPipeDirection()); + } + + /** Selects the given pipe address. Any pipe operations which do not require the pipe address to be + * indicated will operate on the currently selected pipe. + * + * \param[in] Address Address of the pipe to select. + */ + static inline void Pipe_SelectPipe(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_SelectPipe(const uint8_t Address) + { + USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe = (Address & PIPE_EPNUM_MASK); + } + + /** Resets the desired pipe, including the pipe banks and flags. + * + * \param[in] Address Index of the pipe to reset. + */ + static inline void Pipe_ResetPipe(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_ResetPipe(const uint8_t Address) + { + uint32_t PipeNumber = (Address & PIPE_EPNUM_MASK); + + AVR32_USBB.uprst |= (AVR32_USBB_PRST0_MASK << PipeNumber); + AVR32_USBB.uprst &= ~(AVR32_USBB_PRST0_MASK << PipeNumber); + USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[PipeNumber] = &AVR32_USBB_SLAVE[PipeNumber * PIPE_HSB_ADDRESS_SPACE_SIZE]; + } + + /** Enables the currently selected pipe so that data can be sent and received through it to and from + * an attached device. + * + * \pre The currently selected pipe must first be configured properly via \ref Pipe_ConfigurePipe(). + */ + static inline void Pipe_EnablePipe(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_EnablePipe(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.uprst |= (AVR32_USBB_PEN0_MASK << USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe); + } + + /** Disables the currently selected pipe so that data cannot be sent and received through it to and + * from an attached device. + */ + static inline void Pipe_DisablePipe(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_DisablePipe(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.uprst &= ~(AVR32_USBB_PEN0_MASK << USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe); + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected pipe is enabled, but not necessarily configured. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the currently selected pipe is enabled, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsEnabled(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsEnabled(void) + { + return ((AVR32_USBB.uprst & (AVR32_USBB_PEN0_MASK << USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Gets the current pipe token, indicating the pipe's data direction and type. + * + * \return The current pipe token, as a \c PIPE_TOKEN_* mask. + */ + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetPipeToken(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetPipeToken(void) + { + return (&AVR32_USBB.UPCFG0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].ptoken; + } + + /** Sets the token for the currently selected pipe to one of the tokens specified by the \c PIPE_TOKEN_* + * masks. This can be used on CONTROL type pipes, to allow for bidirectional transfer of data during + * control requests, or on regular pipes to allow for half-duplex bidirectional data transfer to devices + * which have two endpoints of opposite direction sharing the same endpoint address within the device. + * + * \param[in] Token New pipe token to set the selected pipe to, as a \c PIPE_TOKEN_* mask. + */ + static inline void Pipe_SetPipeToken(const uint8_t Token) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_SetPipeToken(const uint8_t Token) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.UPCFG0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].ptoken = Token; + } + + /** Configures the currently selected pipe to allow for an unlimited number of IN requests. */ + static inline void Pipe_SetInfiniteINRequests(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_SetInfiniteINRequests(void) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.UPINRQ0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].inmode = true; + } + + /** Configures the currently selected pipe to only allow the specified number of IN requests to be + * accepted by the pipe before it is automatically frozen. + * + * \param[in] TotalINRequests Total number of IN requests that the pipe may receive before freezing. + */ + static inline void Pipe_SetFiniteINRequests(const uint8_t TotalINRequests) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_SetFiniteINRequests(const uint8_t TotalINRequests) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.UPINRQ0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].inmode = false; + (&AVR32_USBB.UPINRQ0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].inrq = TotalINRequests; + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected pipe is configured. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the selected pipe is configured, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsConfigured(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsConfigured(void) + { + return (&AVR32_USBB.UPSTA0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].cfgok; + } + + /** Retrieves the endpoint address of the endpoint within the attached device that the currently selected + * pipe is bound to. + * + * \return Endpoint address the currently selected pipe is bound to. + */ + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetBoundEndpointAddress(void) + { + return ((&AVR32_USBB.UPCFG0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].pepnum | + ((Pipe_GetPipeToken() == PIPE_TOKEN_IN) ? PIPE_DIR_IN : PIPE_DIR_OUT)); + } + + /** Sets the period between interrupts for an INTERRUPT type pipe to a specified number of milliseconds. + * + * \param[in] Milliseconds Number of milliseconds between each pipe poll. + */ + static inline void Pipe_SetInterruptPeriod(const uint8_t Milliseconds) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_SetInterruptPeriod(const uint8_t Milliseconds) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.UPCFG0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].intfrq = Milliseconds; + } + + /** Returns a mask indicating which pipe's interrupt periods have elapsed, indicating that the pipe should + * be serviced. + * + * \return Mask whose bits indicate which pipes have interrupted. + */ + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetPipeInterrupts(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetPipeInterrupts(void) + { + return ((AVR32_USBB.uhint & (AVR32_USBB_P6INT_MASK | AVR32_USBB_P5INT_MASK | + AVR32_USBB_P4INT_MASK | AVR32_USBB_P3INT_MASK | + AVR32_USBB_P2INT_MASK | AVR32_USBB_P1INT_MASK | + AVR32_USBB_P0INT_MASK)) >> AVR32_USBB_P0INT_OFFSET); + } + + /** Determines if the specified pipe address has interrupted (valid only for INTERRUPT type + * pipes). + * + * \param[in] Address Address of the pipe whose interrupt flag should be tested. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the specified pipe has interrupted, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_HasPipeInterrupted(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_HasPipeInterrupted(const uint8_t Address) + { + return ((AVR32_USBB.uhint & (AVR32_USBB_P0INTES_MASK << (Address & PIPE_EPNUM_MASK))) ? true : false); + } + + /** Unfreezes the selected pipe, allowing it to communicate with an attached device. */ + static inline void Pipe_Unfreeze(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Unfreeze(void) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.UPCON0CLR)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].pfreezec = true; + } + + /** Freezes the selected pipe, preventing it from communicating with an attached device. */ + static inline void Pipe_Freeze(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Freeze(void) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.UPCON0SET)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].pfreezes = true; + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected pipe is frozen, and not able to accept data. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the currently selected pipe is frozen, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsFrozen(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsFrozen(void) + { + return (((&AVR32_USBB.UPCON0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].pfreeze) ? true : false); + } + + /** Clears the error flags for the currently selected pipe. */ + static inline void Pipe_ClearError(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_ClearError(void) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.uperr0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe] = 0; + (&AVR32_USBB.UPSTA0CLR)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].overfic = true; + } + + /** Determines if the master pipe error flag is set for the currently selected pipe, indicating that + * some sort of hardware error has occurred on the pipe. + * + * \see \ref Pipe_GetErrorFlags() macro for information on retrieving the exact error flag. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if an error has occurred on the selected pipe, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsError(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsError(void) + { + return (((&AVR32_USBB.upsta0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe] & + (AVR32_USBB_PERRI_MASK | AVR32_USBB_OVERFI_MASK)) ? true : false); + } + + /** Gets a mask of the hardware error flags which have occurred on the currently selected pipe. This + * value can then be masked against the \c PIPE_ERRORFLAG_* masks to determine what error has occurred. + * + * \return Mask comprising of \c PIPE_ERRORFLAG_* bits indicating what error has occurred on the selected pipe. + */ + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetErrorFlags(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetErrorFlags(void) + { + + return (((&AVR32_USBB.uperr0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe] & + (PIPE_ERRORFLAG_CRC16 | PIPE_ERRORFLAG_TIMEOUT | + PIPE_ERRORFLAG_PID | PIPE_ERRORFLAG_DATAPID | + PIPE_ERRORFLAG_DATATGL)) | + (((&AVR32_USBB.upsta0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe] << 8) & + PIPE_ERRORFLAG_OVERFLOW)); + } + + /** Retrieves the number of busy banks in the currently selected pipe, which have been queued for + * transmission via the \ref Pipe_ClearOUT() command, or are awaiting acknowledgement via the + * \ref Pipe_ClearIN() command. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_UC3 + * + * \return Total number of busy banks in the selected pipe. + */ + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetBusyBanks(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Pipe_GetBusyBanks(void) + { + return (&AVR32_USBB.UPSTA0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].nbusybk; + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected pipe may be read from (if data is waiting in the pipe + * bank and the pipe is an IN direction, or if the bank is not yet full if the pipe is an OUT + * direction). This function will return false if an error has occurred in the pipe, or if the pipe + * is an IN direction and no packet (or an empty packet) has been received, or if the pipe is an OUT + * direction and the pipe bank is full. + * + * \note This function is not valid on CONTROL type pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_UC3 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the currently selected pipe may be read from or written to, depending + * on its direction. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed(void) + { + return (&AVR32_USBB.UPSTA0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].rwall; + } + + /** Determines if a packet has been received on the currently selected IN pipe from the attached device. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_UC3 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the current pipe has received an IN packet, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsINReceived(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsINReceived(void) + { + return (&AVR32_USBB.UPSTA0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].rxini; + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected OUT pipe is ready to send an OUT packet to the attached device. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_UC3 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the current pipe is ready for an OUT packet, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsOUTReady(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsOUTReady(void) + { + return (&AVR32_USBB.UPSTA0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].txouti; + } + + /** Determines if no SETUP request is currently being sent to the attached device on the selected + * CONTROL type pipe. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_UC3 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the current pipe is ready for a SETUP packet, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsSETUPSent(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsSETUPSent(void) + { + return (&AVR32_USBB.UPSTA0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].txstpi; + } + + /** Sends the currently selected CONTROL type pipe's contents to the device as a SETUP packet. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_UC3 + */ + static inline void Pipe_ClearSETUP(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_ClearSETUP(void) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.UPSTA0CLR)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].txstpic = true; + (&AVR32_USBB.UPCON0CLR)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].fifoconc = true; + USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe] = &AVR32_USBB_SLAVE[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe * PIPE_HSB_ADDRESS_SPACE_SIZE]; + } + + /** Acknowledges the reception of a setup IN request from the attached device on the currently selected + * pipe, freeing the bank ready for the next packet. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_UC3 + */ + static inline void Pipe_ClearIN(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_ClearIN(void) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.UPSTA0CLR)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].rxinic = true; + (&AVR32_USBB.UPCON0CLR)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].fifoconc = true; + USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe] = &AVR32_USBB_SLAVE[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe * PIPE_HSB_ADDRESS_SPACE_SIZE]; + } + + /** Sends the currently selected pipe's contents to the device as an OUT packet on the selected pipe, freeing + * the bank ready for the next packet. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_UC3 + */ + static inline void Pipe_ClearOUT(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_ClearOUT(void) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.UPSTA0CLR)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].txoutic = true; + (&AVR32_USBB.UPCON0CLR)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].fifoconc = true; + USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe] = &AVR32_USBB_SLAVE[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe * PIPE_HSB_ADDRESS_SPACE_SIZE]; + } + + /** Determines if the device sent a NAK (Negative Acknowledge) in response to the last sent packet on + * the currently selected pipe. This occurs when the host sends a packet to the device, but the device + * is not currently ready to handle the packet (i.e. its endpoint banks are full). Once a NAK has been + * received, it must be cleared using \ref Pipe_ClearNAKReceived() before the previous (or any other) packet + * can be re-sent. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_UC3 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if an NAK has been received on the current pipe, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsNAKReceived(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsNAKReceived(void) + { + return (&AVR32_USBB.UPSTA0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].nakedi; + } + + /** Clears the NAK condition on the currently selected pipe. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_UC3 + * + * \see \ref Pipe_IsNAKReceived() for more details. + */ + static inline void Pipe_ClearNAKReceived(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_ClearNAKReceived(void) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.UPSTA0CLR)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].nakedic = true; + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected pipe has had the STALL condition set by the attached device. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_UC3 + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the current pipe has been stalled by the attached device, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Pipe_IsStalled(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Pipe_IsStalled(void) + { + return (&AVR32_USBB.UPSTA0)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].rxstalldi; + } + + /** Clears the STALL condition detection flag on the currently selected pipe, but does not clear the + * STALL condition itself (this must be done via a ClearFeature control request to the device). + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePacketManagement_UC3 + */ + static inline void Pipe_ClearStall(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_ClearStall(void) + { + (&AVR32_USBB.UPSTA0CLR)[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe].rxstalldic = true; + USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe] = &AVR32_USBB_SLAVE[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe * PIPE_HSB_ADDRESS_SPACE_SIZE]; + } + + /** Reads one byte from the currently selected pipe's bank, for OUT direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \return Next byte in the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint8_t Pipe_Read_8(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Pipe_Read_8(void) + { + return *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + } + + /** Writes one byte to the currently selected pipe's bank, for IN direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write into the the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Pipe_Write_8(const uint8_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Write_8(const uint8_t Data) + { + *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++) = Data; + } + + /** Discards one byte from the currently selected pipe's bank, for OUT direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_UC3 + */ + static inline void Pipe_Discard_8(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Discard_8(void) + { + uint8_t Dummy; + + Dummy = *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + + (void)Dummy; + } + + /** Reads two bytes from the currently selected pipe's bank in little endian format, for OUT + * direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \return Next two bytes in the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint16_t Pipe_Read_16_LE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint16_t Pipe_Read_16_LE(void) + { + uint16_t Byte0 = *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + uint16_t Byte1 = *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + + return ((Byte1 << 8) | Byte0); + } + + /** Reads two bytes from the currently selected pipe's bank in big endian format, for OUT + * direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \return Next two bytes in the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint16_t Pipe_Read_16_BE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint16_t Pipe_Read_16_BE(void) + { + uint16_t Byte0 = *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + uint16_t Byte1 = *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + + return ((Byte0 << 8) | Byte1); + } + + /** Writes two bytes to the currently selected pipe's bank in little endian format, for IN + * direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Pipe_Write_16_LE(const uint16_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Write_16_LE(const uint16_t Data) + { + *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++) = (Data & 0xFF); + *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++) = (Data >> 8); + } + + /** Writes two bytes to the currently selected pipe's bank in big endian format, for IN + * direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Pipe_Write_16_BE(const uint16_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Write_16_BE(const uint16_t Data) + { + *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++) = (Data >> 8); + *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++) = (Data & 0xFF); + } + + /** Discards two bytes from the currently selected pipe's bank, for OUT direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_UC3 + */ + static inline void Pipe_Discard_16(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Discard_16(void) + { + uint8_t Dummy; + + Dummy = *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + Dummy = *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + + (void)Dummy; + } + + /** Reads four bytes from the currently selected pipe's bank in little endian format, for OUT + * direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \return Next four bytes in the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint32_t Pipe_Read_32_LE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint32_t Pipe_Read_32_LE(void) + { + uint32_t Byte0 = *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + uint32_t Byte1 = *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + uint32_t Byte2 = *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + uint32_t Byte3 = *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + + return ((Byte3 << 24) | (Byte2 << 16) | (Byte1 << 8) | Byte0); + } + + /** Reads four bytes from the currently selected pipe's bank in big endian format, for OUT + * direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \return Next four bytes in the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint32_t Pipe_Read_32_BE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint32_t Pipe_Read_32_BE(void) + { + uint32_t Byte0 = *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + uint32_t Byte1 = *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + uint32_t Byte2 = *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + uint32_t Byte3 = *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + + return ((Byte0 << 24) | (Byte1 << 16) | (Byte2 << 8) | Byte3); + } + + /** Writes four bytes to the currently selected pipe's bank in little endian format, for IN + * direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Pipe_Write_32_LE(const uint32_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Write_32_LE(const uint32_t Data) + { + *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++) = (Data & 0xFF); + *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++) = (Data >> 8); + *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++) = (Data >> 16); + *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++) = (Data >> 24); + } + + /** Writes four bytes to the currently selected pipe's bank in big endian format, for IN + * direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_UC3 + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected pipe's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Pipe_Write_32_BE(const uint32_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Write_32_BE(const uint32_t Data) + { + *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++) = (Data >> 24); + *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++) = (Data >> 16); + *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++) = (Data >> 8); + *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++) = (Data & 0xFF); + } + + /** Discards four bytes from the currently selected pipe's bank, for OUT direction pipes. + * + * \ingroup Group_PipePrimitiveRW_UC3 + */ + static inline void Pipe_Discard_32(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Pipe_Discard_32(void) + { + uint8_t Dummy; + + Dummy = *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + Dummy = *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + Dummy = *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + Dummy = *(USB_Pipe_FIFOPos[USB_Pipe_SelectedPipe]++); + + (void)Dummy; + } + + /* External Variables: */ + /** Global indicating the maximum packet size of the default control pipe located at address + * 0 in the device. This value is set to the value indicated in the attached device's device + * descriptor once the USB interface is initialized into host mode and a device is attached + * to the USB bus. + * + * \attention This variable should be treated as read-only in the user application, and never manually + * changed in value. + */ + extern uint8_t USB_Host_ControlPipeSize; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Configures a table of pipe descriptions, in sequence. This function can be used to configure multiple + * pipes at the same time. + * + * \note Pipe with a zero address will be ignored, thus this function cannot be used to configure the + * control pipe. + * + * \param[in] Table Pointer to a table of pipe descriptions. + * \param[in] Entries Number of entries in the pipe table to configure. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if all pipes configured successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool Pipe_ConfigurePipeTable(const USB_Pipe_Table_t* const Table, + const uint8_t Entries); + + /** Configures the specified pipe address with the given pipe type, endpoint address within the attached device, + * bank size and number of hardware banks. + * + * A newly configured pipe is frozen by default, and must be unfrozen before use via the \ref Pipe_Unfreeze() + * before being used. Pipes should be kept frozen unless waiting for data from a device while in IN mode, or + * sending data to the device in OUT mode. IN type pipes are also automatically configured to accept infinite + * numbers of IN requests without automatic freezing - this can be overridden by a call to + * \ref Pipe_SetFiniteINRequests(). + * + * \param[in] Address Pipe address to configure. + * + * \param[in] Type Type of pipe to configure, an \c EP_TYPE_* mask. Not all pipe types are available on Low + * Speed USB devices - refer to the USB 2.0 specification. + * + * \param[in] EndpointAddress Endpoint address within the attached device that the pipe should interface to. + * + * \param[in] Size Size of the pipe's bank, where packets are stored before they are transmitted to + * the USB device, or after they have been received from the USB device (depending on + * the pipe's data direction). The bank size must indicate the maximum packet size that + * the pipe can handle. + * + * \param[in] Banks Number of banks to use for the pipe being configured. + * + * \note When the \c ORDERED_EP_CONFIG compile time option is used, Pipes <b>must</b> be configured in ascending order, + * or bank corruption will occur. + * \n\n + * + * \note Certain microcontroller model's pipes may have different maximum packet sizes based on the pipe's + * index - refer to the chosen microcontroller's datasheet to determine the maximum bank size for each pipe. + * \n\n + * + * \note The default control pipe should not be manually configured by the user application, as it is + * automatically configured by the library internally. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine will automatically select the specified pipe upon success. Upon failure, the pipe which + * failed to reconfigure correctly will be selected. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the configuration succeeded, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool Pipe_ConfigurePipe(const uint8_t Address, + const uint8_t Type, + const uint8_t EndpointAddress, + const uint16_t Size, + const uint8_t Banks); + + /** Spin-loops until the currently selected non-control pipe is ready for the next packet of data to be read + * or written to it, aborting in the case of an error condition (such as a timeout or device disconnect). + * + * \ingroup Group_PipeRW_UC3 + * + * \return A value from the \ref Pipe_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Pipe_WaitUntilReady(void); + + /** Determines if a pipe has been bound to the given device endpoint address. If a pipe which is bound to the given + * endpoint is found, it is automatically selected. + * + * \param[in] EndpointAddress Address and direction mask of the endpoint within the attached device to check. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if a pipe bound to the given endpoint address of the specified direction is found, + * \c false otherwise. + */ + bool Pipe_IsEndpointBound(const uint8_t EndpointAddress) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #if !defined(ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP) + #define ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP 0 + #endif + + /* Inline Functions: */ + static inline uint8_t Pipe_BytesToEPSizeMask(const uint16_t Bytes) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_CONST ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Pipe_BytesToEPSizeMask(const uint16_t Bytes) + { + uint8_t MaskVal = 0; + uint16_t CheckBytes = 8; + + while ((CheckBytes < Bytes) && (CheckBytes < PIPE_MAX_SIZE)) + { + MaskVal++; + CheckBytes <<= 1; + } + + return (MaskVal << AVR32_USBB_PSIZE_OFFSET); + } + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void Pipe_ClearPipes(void); + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f6c4beb229 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c @@ -0,0 +1,84 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#if defined(TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME) + +uint8_t TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME (void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) +{ + uint8_t* DataStream = ((uint8_t*)Buffer + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length)); + + if (!(Length)) + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + while (Length) + { + uint8_t USB_DeviceState_LCL = USB_DeviceState; + + if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + else if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Suspended) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_BusSuspended; + else if (Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived()) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_HostAborted; + + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + { + while (Length && Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint()) + { + TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(DataStream); + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(DataStream, 1); + Length--; + } + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + } + + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) + { + uint8_t USB_DeviceState_LCL = USB_DeviceState; + + if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + else if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Suspended) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_BusSuspended; + } + + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_NoError; +} + +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE +#undef TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME +#undef TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..922b58efa3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c @@ -0,0 +1,95 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#if defined(TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME) + +uint8_t TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME (const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) +{ + uint8_t* DataStream = ((uint8_t*)Buffer + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length)); + bool LastPacketFull = false; + + if (Length > USB_ControlRequest.wLength) + Length = USB_ControlRequest.wLength; + else if (!(Length)) + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + while (Length || LastPacketFull) + { + uint8_t USB_DeviceState_LCL = USB_DeviceState; + + if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + else if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Suspended) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_BusSuspended; + else if (Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived()) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_HostAborted; + else if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + break; + + if (Endpoint_IsINReady()) + { + uint16_t BytesInEndpoint = Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint(); + + while (Length && (BytesInEndpoint < USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize)) + { + TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(DataStream); + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(DataStream, 1); + Length--; + BytesInEndpoint++; + } + + LastPacketFull = (BytesInEndpoint == USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } + } + + while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) + { + uint8_t USB_DeviceState_LCL = USB_DeviceState; + + if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + else if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Suspended) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_BusSuspended; + else if (Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived()) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_HostAborted; + } + + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_NoError; +} + +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE +#undef TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME +#undef TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e55e592eb2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c @@ -0,0 +1,89 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#if defined(TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME) + +uint8_t TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME (TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) +{ + uint8_t* DataStream = ((uint8_t*)Buffer + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length)); + uint16_t BytesInTransfer = 0; + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + Length -= *BytesProcessed; + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(DataStream, *BytesProcessed); + } + + while (Length) + { + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT(); + + #if !defined(INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT) + USB_USBTask(); + #endif + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + *BytesProcessed += BytesInTransfer; + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + } + else + { + TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(DataStream); + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(DataStream, 1); + Length--; + BytesInTransfer++; + } + } + + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +#undef TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE +#undef TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE +#undef TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bb2a57fa52 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c @@ -0,0 +1,88 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#if defined(TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME) + +uint8_t TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME (TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) +{ + uint8_t* DataStream = ((uint8_t*)Buffer + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length)); + uint16_t BytesInTransfer = 0; + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + Pipe_SetPipeToken(TEMPLATE_TOKEN); + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + Length -= *BytesProcessed; + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(DataStream, *BytesProcessed); + } + + while (Length) + { + if (!(Pipe_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + TEMPLATE_CLEAR_PIPE(); + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + *BytesProcessed += BytesInTransfer; + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = Pipe_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + } + else + { + TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(DataStream); + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(DataStream, 1); + Length--; + BytesInTransfer++; + } + } + + return PIPE_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +#undef TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE +#undef TEMPLATE_TOKEN +#undef TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE +#undef TEMPLATE_CLEAR_PIPE +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/USBController_UC3.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/USBController_UC3.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2b1e9ac6b8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/USBController_UC3.c @@ -0,0 +1,222 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_CONTROLLER_C +#include "../USBController.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) +volatile uint8_t USB_CurrentMode = USB_MODE_None; +#endif + +#if !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS) +volatile uint8_t USB_Options; +#endif + +void USB_Init( + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + const uint8_t Mode + #endif + + #if (defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) && !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS)) + , + #elif (!defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) && defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS)) + void + #endif + + #if !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS) + const uint8_t Options + #endif + ) +{ + #if !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS) + USB_Options = Options; + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + if (Mode == USB_MODE_UID) + { + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.uide = true; + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_IDTI); + USB_CurrentMode = USB_GetUSBModeFromUID(); + } + else + { + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.uide = false; + USB_CurrentMode = Mode; + } + #else + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.uide = false; + #endif + + USB_IsInitialized = true; + + USB_ResetInterface(); +} + +void USB_Disable(void) +{ + USB_INT_DisableAllInterrupts(); + USB_INT_ClearAllInterrupts(); + + USB_Detach(); + USB_Controller_Disable(); + + USB_OTGPAD_Off(); + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + USB_CurrentMode = USB_MODE_None; + #endif + + AVR32_PM.GCCTRL[3].cen = false; + + USB_IsInitialized = false; +} + +void USB_ResetInterface(void) +{ + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + bool UIDModeSelectEnabled = AVR32_USBB.USBCON.uide; + #endif + + AVR32_PM.GCCTRL[AVR32_PM_GCLK_USBB].pllsel = !(USB_Options & USB_OPT_GCLK_SRC_OSC); + AVR32_PM.GCCTRL[AVR32_PM_GCLK_USBB].oscsel = !(USB_Options & USB_OPT_GCLK_CHANNEL_0); + AVR32_PM.GCCTRL[AVR32_PM_GCLK_USBB].diven = (F_USB != USB_CLOCK_REQUIRED_FREQ); + AVR32_PM.GCCTRL[AVR32_PM_GCLK_USBB].div = (F_USB == USB_CLOCK_REQUIRED_FREQ) ? 0 : (uint32_t)((F_USB / USB_CLOCK_REQUIRED_FREQ / 2) - 1); + AVR32_PM.GCCTRL[AVR32_PM_GCLK_USBB].cen = true; + + USB_INT_DisableAllInterrupts(); + USB_INT_ClearAllInterrupts(); + + USB_Controller_Reset(); + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + if (UIDModeSelectEnabled) + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_IDTI); + #endif + + USB_CLK_Unfreeze(); + + if (USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Device) + { + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.uimod = true; + + USB_Init_Device(); + #endif + } + else if (USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Host) + { + #if defined(INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE) + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.vbuspo = true; + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.uimod = false; + + USB_Init_Host(); + #endif + } + + USB_OTGPAD_On(); +} + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) +static void USB_Init_Device(void) +{ + USB_DeviceState = DEVICE_STATE_Unattached; + USB_Device_ConfigurationNumber = 0; + + #if !defined(NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP) + USB_Device_RemoteWakeupEnabled = false; + #endif + + #if !defined(NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER) + USB_Device_CurrentlySelfPowered = false; + #endif + + #if !defined(FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE) + USB_Descriptor_Device_t* DeviceDescriptorPtr; + + if (CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor((DTYPE_Device << 8), 0, (void*)&DeviceDescriptorPtr) != NO_DESCRIPTOR) + USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize = DeviceDescriptorPtr->Endpoint0Size; + #endif + + if (USB_Options & USB_DEVICE_OPT_LOWSPEED) + { + USB_Device_SetLowSpeed(); + } + else + { + #if defined(USB_DEVICE_OPT_HIGHSPEED) + if (USB_Options & USB_DEVICE_OPT_HIGHSPEED) + USB_Device_SetHighSpeed(); + else + USB_Device_SetFullSpeed(); + #else + USB_Device_SetFullSpeed(); + #endif + } + + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_VBUSTI); + + Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP, EP_TYPE_CONTROL, + USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize, 1); + + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_SUSPI); + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_SUSPI); + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_EORSTI); + + USB_Attach(); +} +#endif + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) +static void USB_Init_Host(void) +{ + USB_HostState = HOST_STATE_Unattached; + USB_Host_ConfigurationNumber = 0; + USB_Host_ControlPipeSize = PIPE_CONTROLPIPE_DEFAULT_SIZE; + + USB_Host_HostMode_On(); + + USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_On(); + + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_DCONNI); + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_BCERRI); + + USB_Attach(); +} +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/USBController_UC3.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/USBController_UC3.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..32c2f6ec17 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/USBController_UC3.h @@ -0,0 +1,353 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Controller definitions for the AVR32 UC3 microcontrollers. + * \copydetails Group_USBManagement_UC3 + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBManagement + * \defgroup Group_USBManagement_UC3 USB Interface Management (UC3) + * \brief USB Controller definitions for the AVR32 UC3 microcontrollers. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to the setup and management of the USB interface. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __USBCONTROLLER_UC3_H__ +#define __USBCONTROLLER_UC3_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../USBMode.h" + #include "../Events.h" + #include "../USBTask.h" + #include "../USBInterrupt.h" + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #include "../Host.h" + #include "../OTG.h" + #include "../Pipe.h" + #include "../HostStandardReq.h" + #include "../PipeStream.h" + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #include "../Device.h" + #include "../Endpoint.h" + #include "../DeviceStandardReq.h" + #include "../EndpointStream.h" + #endif + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks and Defines: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + #if !defined(F_USB) + #error F_USB is not defined. You must define F_USB to the frequency of the clock input to the USB module. + #endif + + #if (defined(USB_SERIES_UC3A3_AVR) || defined(USB_SERIES_UC3A4_AVR)) + #if ((F_USB < 12000000) || (F_USB % 12000000)) + #error Invalid F_USB specified. F_USB must be a multiple of 12MHz for UC3A3 and UC3A4 devices. + #endif + #else + #if ((F_USB < 48000000) || (F_USB % 48000000)) + #error Invalid F_USB specified. F_USB must be a multiple of 48MHz for UC3A and UC3B devices. + #endif + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** \name USB Controller Option Masks */ + //@{ + /** Selects one of the system's main clock oscillators as the input clock to the USB Generic Clock source + * generation module. This indicates that an external oscillator should be used directly instead of an + * internal PLL clock source. + */ + #define USB_OPT_GCLK_SRC_OSC (1 << 2) + + /** Selects one of the system's PLL oscillators as the input clock to the USB Generic Clock source + * generation module. This indicates that one of the device's PLL outputs should be used instead of an + * external oscillator source. + */ + #define USB_OPT_GCLK_SRC_PLL (0 << 2) + + /** Selects PLL or External Oscillator 0 as the USB Generic Clock source module input clock. */ + #define USB_OPT_GCLK_CHANNEL_0 (1 << 3) + + /** Selects PLL or External Oscillator 1 as the USB Generic Clock source module input clock. */ + #define USB_OPT_GCLK_CHANNEL_1 (0 << 3) + //@} + + #if !defined(USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Constant for the maximum software timeout period of the USB data stream transfer functions + * (both control and standard) when in either device or host mode. If the next packet of a stream + * is not received or acknowledged within this time period, the stream function will fail. + * + * This value may be overridden in the user project makefile as the value of the + * \ref USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS token, and passed to the compiler using the -D switch. + */ + #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS 100 + #endif + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Determines if the VBUS line is currently high (i.e. the USB host is supplying power). + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the VBUS line is currently detecting power from a host, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool USB_VBUS_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool USB_VBUS_GetStatus(void) + { + return AVR32_USBB.USBSTA.vbus; + } + + /** Detaches the device from the USB bus. This has the effect of removing the device from any + * attached host, ceasing USB communications. If no host is present, this prevents any host from + * enumerating the device once attached until \ref USB_Attach() is called. + */ + static inline void USB_Detach(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Detach(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.UDCON.detach = true; + } + + /** Attaches the device to the USB bus. This announces the device's presence to any attached + * USB host, starting the enumeration process. If no host is present, attaching the device + * will allow for enumeration once a host is connected to the device. + * + * This is inexplicably also required for proper operation while in host mode, to enable the + * attachment of a device to the host. This is despite the bit being located in the device-mode + * register and despite the datasheet making no mention of its requirement in host mode. + */ + static inline void USB_Attach(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Attach(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.UDCON.detach = false; + } + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Main function to initialize and start the USB interface. Once active, the USB interface will + * allow for device connection to a host when in device mode, or for device enumeration while in + * host mode. + * + * As the USB library relies on interrupts for the device and host mode enumeration processes, + * the user must enable global interrupts before or shortly after this function is called. In + * device mode, interrupts must be enabled within 500ms of this function being called to ensure + * that the host does not time out whilst enumerating the device. In host mode, interrupts may be + * enabled at the application's leisure however enumeration will not begin of an attached device + * until after this has occurred. + * + * Calling this function when the USB interface is already initialized will cause a complete USB + * interface reset and re-enumeration. + * + * \param[in] Mode Mask indicating what mode the USB interface is to be initialized to, a value + * from the \ref USB_Modes_t enum. + * \note This parameter does not exist on devices with only one supported USB + * mode (device or host). + * + * \param[in] Options Mask indicating the options which should be used when initializing the USB + * interface to control the USB interface's behavior. This should be comprised of + * a \c USB_OPT_REG_* mask to control the regulator, a \c USB_OPT_*_PLL mask to control the + * PLL, and a \c USB_DEVICE_OPT_* mask (when the device mode is enabled) to set the device + * mode speed. + * + * \note To reduce the FLASH requirements of the library if only device or host mode is required, + * the mode can be statically set in the project makefile by defining the token \c USB_DEVICE_ONLY + * (for device mode) or \c USB_HOST_ONLY (for host mode), passing the token to the compiler + * via the -D switch. If the mode is statically set, this parameter does not exist in the + * function prototype. + * \n\n + * + * \note To reduce the FLASH requirements of the library if only fixed settings are required, + * the options may be set statically in the same manner as the mode (see the Mode parameter of + * this function). To statically set the USB options, pass in the \c USE_STATIC_OPTIONS token, + * defined to the appropriate options masks. When the options are statically set, this + * parameter does not exist in the function prototype. + * + * \see \ref Group_Device for the \c USB_DEVICE_OPT_* masks. + */ + void USB_Init( + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + const uint8_t Mode + #endif + + #if (defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) && !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS)) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + , + #elif (!defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) && defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS)) + void + #endif + + #if !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + const uint8_t Options + #endif + ); + + /** Shuts down the USB interface. This turns off the USB interface after deallocating all USB FIFO + * memory, endpoints and pipes. When turned off, no USB functionality can be used until the interface + * is restarted with the \ref USB_Init() function. + */ + void USB_Disable(void); + + /** Resets the interface, when already initialized. This will re-enumerate the device if already connected + * to a host, or re-enumerate an already attached device when in host mode. + */ + void USB_ResetInterface(void); + + /* Global Variables: */ + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Indicates the mode that the USB interface is currently initialized to, a value from the + * \ref USB_Modes_t enum. + * + * \attention This variable should be treated as read-only in the user application, and never manually + * changed in value. + * + * \note When the controller is initialized into UID auto-detection mode, this variable will hold the + * currently selected USB mode (i.e. \ref USB_MODE_Device or \ref USB_MODE_Host). If the controller + * is fixed into a specific mode (either through the \c USB_DEVICE_ONLY or \c USB_HOST_ONLY compile time + * options, or a limitation of the USB controller in the chosen device model) this will evaluate to + * a constant of the appropriate value and will never evaluate to \ref USB_MODE_None even when the + * USB interface is not initialized. + */ + extern volatile uint8_t USB_CurrentMode; + #elif defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + #define USB_CurrentMode USB_MODE_Host + #elif defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + #define USB_CurrentMode USB_MODE_Device + #endif + + #if !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Indicates the current USB options that the USB interface was initialized with when \ref USB_Init() + * was called. This value will be one of the \c USB_MODE_* masks defined elsewhere in this module. + * + * \attention This variable should be treated as read-only in the user application, and never manually + * changed in value. + */ + extern volatile uint8_t USB_Options; + #elif defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS) + #define USB_Options USE_STATIC_OPTIONS + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #if defined(USB_SERIES_UC3A3_AVR32) || defined(USB_SERIES_UC3A4_AVR32) + #define USB_CLOCK_REQUIRED_FREQ 12000000UL + #else + #define USB_CLOCK_REQUIRED_FREQ 48000000UL + #endif + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_CONTROLLER_C) + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + static void USB_Init_Device(void); + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + static void USB_Init_Host(void); + #endif + #endif + + /* Inline Functions: */ + static inline void USB_OTGPAD_On(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_OTGPAD_On(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.otgpade = true; + } + + static inline void USB_OTGPAD_Off(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_OTGPAD_Off(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.otgpade = false; + } + + static inline void USB_CLK_Freeze(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_CLK_Freeze(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.frzclk = true; + } + + static inline void USB_CLK_Unfreeze(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_CLK_Unfreeze(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.frzclk = false; + } + + static inline void USB_Controller_Enable(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Controller_Enable(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.usbe = true; + } + + static inline void USB_Controller_Disable(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Controller_Disable(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.usbe = false; + } + + static inline void USB_Controller_Reset(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Controller_Reset(void) + { + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.usbe = false; + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.usbe = true; + } + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + static inline uint8_t USB_GetUSBModeFromUID(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t USB_GetUSBModeFromUID(void) + { + if (AVR32_USBB.USBSTA.id) + return USB_MODE_Device; + else + return USB_MODE_Host; + } + #endif + + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/USBInterrupt_UC3.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/USBInterrupt_UC3.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3b3958a145 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/USBInterrupt_UC3.c @@ -0,0 +1,228 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBInterrupt.h" + +void USB_INT_DisableAllInterrupts(void) +{ + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.vbuste = false; + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.idte = false; + + AVR32_USBB.uhinteclr = -1; + AVR32_USBB.udinteclr = -1; +} + +void USB_INT_ClearAllInterrupts(void) +{ + AVR32_USBB.USBSTACLR.vbustic = true; + AVR32_USBB.USBSTACLR.idtic = true; + + AVR32_USBB.uhintclr = -1; + AVR32_USBB.udintclr = -1; +} + +ISR(USB_GEN_vect) +{ + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + #if !defined(NO_SOF_EVENTS) + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_SOFI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_SOFI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_SOFI); + + EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(); + } + #endif + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_VBUSTI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_VBUSTI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_VBUSTI); + + if (USB_VBUS_GetStatus()) + { + USB_DeviceState = DEVICE_STATE_Powered; + EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(); + } + else + { + USB_DeviceState = DEVICE_STATE_Unattached; + EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(); + } + } + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_SUSPI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_SUSPI)) + { + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_SUSPI); + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_WAKEUPI); + + USB_CLK_Freeze(); + + USB_DeviceState = DEVICE_STATE_Suspended; + EVENT_USB_Device_Suspend(); + } + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_WAKEUPI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_WAKEUPI)) + { + USB_CLK_Unfreeze(); + + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_WAKEUPI); + + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_WAKEUPI); + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_SUSPI); + + if (USB_Device_ConfigurationNumber) + USB_DeviceState = DEVICE_STATE_Configured; + else + USB_DeviceState = (USB_Device_IsAddressSet()) ? DEVICE_STATE_Addressed : DEVICE_STATE_Powered; + + EVENT_USB_Device_WakeUp(); + } + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_EORSTI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_EORSTI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_EORSTI); + + USB_DeviceState = DEVICE_STATE_Default; + USB_Device_ConfigurationNumber = 0; + + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_SUSPI); + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_SUSPI); + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_WAKEUPI); + + USB_Device_SetDeviceAddress(0); + Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP, EP_TYPE_CONTROL, + USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize, 1); + + #if defined(INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT) + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_RXSTPI); + #endif + + EVENT_USB_Device_Reset(); + } + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + #if !defined(NO_SOF_EVENTS) + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_HSOFI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_HSOFI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_HSOFI); + + EVENT_USB_Host_StartOfFrame(); + } + #endif + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_DDISCI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_DDISCI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_DDISCI); + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_DCONNI); + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_DDISCI); + + EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(); + + USB_ResetInterface(); + } + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_VBERRI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_VBERRI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_VBERRI); + + USB_Host_VBUS_Manual_Off(); + USB_Host_VBUS_Auto_Off(); + + EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(HOST_ERROR_VBusVoltageDip); + EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(); + + USB_HostState = HOST_STATE_Unattached; + } + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_DCONNI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_DCONNI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_DCONNI); + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_DCONNI); + + EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(); + + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_DDISCI); + + USB_HostState = HOST_STATE_Powered; + } + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_BCERRI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_BCERRI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_BCERRI); + + EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(HOST_ENUMERROR_NoDeviceDetected, 0); + EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(); + + USB_ResetInterface(); + } + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_IDTI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_IDTI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_IDTI); + + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(); + + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Unattached) + EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(); + + USB_CurrentMode = USB_GetUSBModeFromUID(); + USB_ResetInterface(); + + EVENT_USB_UIDChange(); + } + #endif +} + +#if defined(INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT) && defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) +ISR(USB_COM_vect) +{ + uint8_t PrevSelectedEndpoint = Endpoint_GetCurrentEndpoint(); + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP); + USB_INT_Disable(USB_INT_RXSTPI); + + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + USB_Device_ProcessControlRequest(); + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP); + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_RXSTPI); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(PrevSelectedEndpoint); +} +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/USBInterrupt_UC3.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/USBInterrupt_UC3.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e2f67bf86a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/USBInterrupt_UC3.h @@ -0,0 +1,376 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Controller Interrupt definitions for the AVR32 UC3 microcontrollers. + * + * This file contains definitions required for the correct handling of low level USB service routine interrupts + * from the USB controller. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +#ifndef __USBINTERRUPT_UC3_H__ +#define __USBINTERRUPT_UC3_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* External Variables: */ + extern volatile uint32_t USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint; + + /* Enums: */ + enum USB_Interrupts_t + { + USB_INT_VBUSTI = 0, + #if (defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + USB_INT_IDTI = 1, + #endif + #if (defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + USB_INT_WAKEUPI = 2, + USB_INT_SUSPI = 3, + USB_INT_EORSTI = 4, + USB_INT_SOFI = 5, + USB_INT_RXSTPI = 6, + #endif + #if (defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + USB_INT_HSOFI = 7, + USB_INT_DCONNI = 8, + USB_INT_DDISCI = 9, + USB_INT_RSTI = 10, + USB_INT_BCERRI = 11, + USB_INT_VBERRI = 12, + #endif + }; + + /* Inline Functions: */ + static inline void USB_INT_Enable(const uint8_t Interrupt) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_INT_Enable(const uint8_t Interrupt) + { + switch (Interrupt) + { + case USB_INT_VBUSTI: + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.vbuste = true; + break; + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + case USB_INT_IDTI: + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.idte = true; + break; + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + case USB_INT_WAKEUPI: + AVR32_USBB.UDINTESET.wakeupes = true; + break; + case USB_INT_SUSPI: + AVR32_USBB.UDINTESET.suspes = true; + break; + case USB_INT_EORSTI: + AVR32_USBB.UDINTESET.eorstes = true; + break; + case USB_INT_SOFI: + AVR32_USBB.UDINTESET.sofes = true; + break; + case USB_INT_RXSTPI: + (&AVR32_USBB.UECON0SET)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].rxstpes = true; + break; + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + case USB_INT_HSOFI: + AVR32_USBB.UHINTESET.hsofies = true; + break; + case USB_INT_DCONNI: + AVR32_USBB.UHINTESET.dconnies = true; + break; + case USB_INT_DDISCI: + AVR32_USBB.UHINTESET.ddiscies = true; + break; + case USB_INT_RSTI: + AVR32_USBB.UHINTESET.rsties = true; + break; + case USB_INT_BCERRI: + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.bcerre = true; + break; + case USB_INT_VBERRI: + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.vberre = true; + break; + #endif + default: + break; + } + } + + static inline void USB_INT_Disable(const uint8_t Interrupt) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_INT_Disable(const uint8_t Interrupt) + { + switch (Interrupt) + { + case USB_INT_VBUSTI: + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.vbuste = false; + break; + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + case USB_INT_IDTI: + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.idte = false; + break; + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + case USB_INT_WAKEUPI: + AVR32_USBB.UDINTECLR.wakeupec = true; + break; + case USB_INT_SUSPI: + AVR32_USBB.UDINTECLR.suspec = true; + break; + case USB_INT_EORSTI: + AVR32_USBB.UDINTECLR.eorstec = true; + break; + case USB_INT_SOFI: + AVR32_USBB.UDINTECLR.sofec = true; + break; + case USB_INT_RXSTPI: + (&AVR32_USBB.UECON0CLR)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].rxstpec = true; + break; + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + case USB_INT_HSOFI: + AVR32_USBB.UHINTECLR.hsofiec = true; + break; + case USB_INT_DCONNI: + AVR32_USBB.UHINTECLR.dconniec = true; + break; + case USB_INT_DDISCI: + AVR32_USBB.UHINTECLR.ddisciec = true; + break; + case USB_INT_RSTI: + AVR32_USBB.UHINTECLR.rstiec = true; + break; + case USB_INT_BCERRI: + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.bcerre = false; + break; + case USB_INT_VBERRI: + AVR32_USBB.USBCON.vberre = false; + break; + #endif + default: + break; + } + } + + static inline void USB_INT_Clear(const uint8_t Interrupt) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_INT_Clear(const uint8_t Interrupt) + { + switch (Interrupt) + { + case USB_INT_VBUSTI: + AVR32_USBB.USBSTACLR.vbustic = true; + (void)AVR32_USBB.USBSTACLR; + break; + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + case USB_INT_IDTI: + AVR32_USBB.USBSTACLR.idtic = true; + (void)AVR32_USBB.USBSTACLR; + break; + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + case USB_INT_WAKEUPI: + AVR32_USBB.UDINTCLR.wakeupc = true; + (void)AVR32_USBB.UDINTCLR; + break; + case USB_INT_SUSPI: + AVR32_USBB.UDINTCLR.suspc = true; + (void)AVR32_USBB.UDINTCLR; + break; + case USB_INT_EORSTI: + AVR32_USBB.UDINTCLR.eorstc = true; + (void)AVR32_USBB.UDINTCLR; + break; + case USB_INT_SOFI: + AVR32_USBB.UDINTCLR.sofc = true; + (void)AVR32_USBB.UDINTCLR; + break; + case USB_INT_RXSTPI: + (&AVR32_USBB.UESTA0CLR)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].rxstpic = true; + break; + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + case USB_INT_HSOFI: + AVR32_USBB.UHINTCLR.hsofic = true; + (void)AVR32_USBB.UHINTCLR; + break; + case USB_INT_DCONNI: + AVR32_USBB.UHINTCLR.dconnic = true; + (void)AVR32_USBB.UHINTCLR; + break; + case USB_INT_DDISCI: + AVR32_USBB.UHINTCLR.ddiscic = true; + (void)AVR32_USBB.UHINTCLR; + break; + case USB_INT_RSTI: + AVR32_USBB.UHINTCLR.rstic = true; + (void)AVR32_USBB.UHINTCLR; + break; + case USB_INT_BCERRI: + AVR32_USBB.USBSTACLR.bcerric = true; + (void)AVR32_USBB.USBSTACLR; + break; + case USB_INT_VBERRI: + AVR32_USBB.USBSTACLR.vberric = true; + (void)AVR32_USBB.USBSTACLR; + break; + #endif + default: + break; + } + } + + static inline bool USB_INT_IsEnabled(const uint8_t Interrupt) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline bool USB_INT_IsEnabled(const uint8_t Interrupt) + { + switch (Interrupt) + { + case USB_INT_VBUSTI: + return AVR32_USBB.USBCON.vbuste; + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + case USB_INT_IDTI: + return AVR32_USBB.USBCON.idte; + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + case USB_INT_WAKEUPI: + return AVR32_USBB.UDINTE.wakeupe; + case USB_INT_SUSPI: + return AVR32_USBB.UDINTE.suspe; + case USB_INT_EORSTI: + return AVR32_USBB.UDINTE.eorste; + case USB_INT_SOFI: + return AVR32_USBB.UDINTE.sofe; + case USB_INT_RXSTPI: + return (&AVR32_USBB.UECON0)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].rxstpe; + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + case USB_INT_HSOFI: + return AVR32_USBB.UHINTE.hsofie; + case USB_INT_DCONNI: + return AVR32_USBB.UHINTE.dconnie; + case USB_INT_DDISCI: + return AVR32_USBB.UHINTE.ddiscie; + case USB_INT_RSTI: + return AVR32_USBB.UHINTE.rstie; + case USB_INT_BCERRI: + return AVR32_USBB.USBCON.bcerre; + case USB_INT_VBERRI: + return AVR32_USBB.USBCON.vberre; + #endif + default: + return false; + } + } + + static inline bool USB_INT_HasOccurred(const uint8_t Interrupt) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline bool USB_INT_HasOccurred(const uint8_t Interrupt) + { + switch (Interrupt) + { + case USB_INT_VBUSTI: + return AVR32_USBB.USBSTA.vbusti; + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + case USB_INT_IDTI: + return AVR32_USBB.USBSTA.idti; + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + case USB_INT_WAKEUPI: + return AVR32_USBB.UDINT.wakeup; + case USB_INT_SUSPI: + return AVR32_USBB.UDINT.susp; + case USB_INT_EORSTI: + return AVR32_USBB.UDINT.eorst; + case USB_INT_SOFI: + return AVR32_USBB.UDINT.sof; + case USB_INT_RXSTPI: + return (&AVR32_USBB.UESTA0)[USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint].rxstpi; + #endif + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + case USB_INT_HSOFI: + return AVR32_USBB.UHINT.hsofi; + case USB_INT_DCONNI: + return AVR32_USBB.UHINT.dconni; + case USB_INT_DDISCI: + return AVR32_USBB.UHINT.ddisci; + case USB_INT_RSTI: + return AVR32_USBB.UHINT.rsti; + case USB_INT_BCERRI: + return AVR32_USBB.USBSTA.bcerri; + case USB_INT_VBERRI: + return AVR32_USBB.USBSTA.vberri; + #endif + default: + return false; + } + } + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../USBMode.h" + #include "../Events.h" + #include "../USBController.h" + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void USB_INT_ClearAllInterrupts(void); + void USB_INT_DisableAllInterrupts(void); + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Interrupt service routine handler for the USB controller ISR group. This interrupt routine <b>must</b> be + * linked to the entire USB controller ISR vector group inside the AVR32's interrupt controller peripheral, + * using the user application's preferred USB controller driver. + */ + void USB_GEN_vect(void); + #else + ISR(USB_GEN_vect); + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/USBController.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/USBController.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5980a37ce6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/USBController.h @@ -0,0 +1,165 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Common USB Controller definitions for all architectures. + * \copydetails Group_USBManagement + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USB + * \defgroup Group_USBManagement USB Interface Management + * \brief USB Controller definitions for general USB controller management. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to the setup and management of the USB interface. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __USBCONTROLLER_H__ +#define __USBCONTROLLER_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "USBMode.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks and Defines: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Defines: */ + /** \name Endpoint Direction Masks */ + //@{ + /** Endpoint direction mask, for masking against endpoint addresses to retrieve the endpoint's + * direction for comparing with the \c ENDPOINT_DIR_* masks. + */ + #define ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK 0x80 + + /** Endpoint address direction mask for an OUT direction (Host to Device) endpoint. This may be ORed with + * the index of the address within a device to obtain the full endpoint address. + */ + #define ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT 0x00 + + /** Endpoint address direction mask for an IN direction (Device to Host) endpoint. This may be ORed with + * the index of the address within a device to obtain the full endpoint address. + */ + #define ENDPOINT_DIR_IN 0x80 + //@} + + /** \name Pipe Direction Masks */ + //@{ + /** Pipe direction mask, for masking against pipe addresses to retrieve the pipe's + * direction for comparing with the \c PIPE_DIR_* masks. + */ + #define PIPE_DIR_MASK 0x80 + + /** Endpoint address direction mask for an OUT direction (Host to Device) endpoint. This may be ORed with + * the index of the address within a device to obtain the full endpoint address. + */ + #define PIPE_DIR_OUT 0x00 + + /** Endpoint address direction mask for an IN direction (Device to Host) endpoint. This may be ORed with + * the index of the address within a device to obtain the full endpoint address. + */ + #define PIPE_DIR_IN 0x80 + //@} + + /** \name Endpoint/Pipe Type Masks */ + //@{ + /** Mask for determining the type of an endpoint from an endpoint descriptor. This should then be compared + * with the \c EP_TYPE_* masks to determine the exact type of the endpoint. + */ + #define EP_TYPE_MASK 0x03 + + /** Mask for a CONTROL type endpoint or pipe. + * + * \note See \ref Group_EndpointManagement and \ref Group_PipeManagement for endpoint/pipe functions. + */ + #define EP_TYPE_CONTROL 0x00 + + /** Mask for an ISOCHRONOUS type endpoint or pipe. + * + * \note See \ref Group_EndpointManagement and \ref Group_PipeManagement for endpoint/pipe functions. + */ + #define EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS 0x01 + + /** Mask for a BULK type endpoint or pipe. + * + * \note See \ref Group_EndpointManagement and \ref Group_PipeManagement for endpoint/pipe functions. + */ + #define EP_TYPE_BULK 0x02 + + /** Mask for an INTERRUPT type endpoint or pipe. + * + * \note See \ref Group_EndpointManagement and \ref Group_PipeManagement for endpoint/pipe functions. + */ + #define EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT 0x03 + //@} + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible USB controller modes, for initialization via \ref USB_Init() and indication back to the + * user application via \ref USB_CurrentMode. + */ + enum USB_Modes_t + { + USB_MODE_None = 0, /**< Indicates that the controller is currently not initialized in any specific USB mode. */ + USB_MODE_Device = 1, /**< Indicates that the controller is currently initialized in USB Device mode. */ + USB_MODE_Host = 2, /**< Indicates that the controller is currently initialized in USB Host mode. */ + USB_MODE_UID = 3, /**< Indicates that the controller should determine the USB mode from the UID pin of the + * USB connector. + */ + }; + + /* Architecture Includes: */ + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + #include "AVR8/USBController_AVR8.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + #include "UC3/USBController_UC3.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + #include "XMEGA/USBController_XMEGA.h" + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/USBInterrupt.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/USBInterrupt.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b00ef7bd39 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/USBInterrupt.h @@ -0,0 +1,73 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB controller interrupt service routine management. + * + * This file contains definitions required for the correct handling of low level USB service routine interrupts + * from the USB controller. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +#ifndef __USBINTERRUPT_H__ +#define __USBINTERRUPT_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "USBMode.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Architecture Includes: */ + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + #include "AVR8/USBInterrupt_AVR8.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + #include "UC3/USBInterrupt_UC3.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + #include "XMEGA/USBInterrupt_XMEGA.h" + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/USBMode.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/USBMode.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2044f899a9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/USBMode.h @@ -0,0 +1,283 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB mode and feature support definitions. + * \copydetails Group_USBMode + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USB + * \defgroup Group_USBMode USB Mode Tokens + * \brief USB mode and feature support definitions. + * + * This file defines macros indicating the type of USB controller the library is being compiled for, and its + * capabilities. These macros may then be referenced in the user application to selectively enable or disable + * code sections depending on if they are defined or not. + * + * After the inclusion of the master USB driver header, one or more of the following tokens may be defined, to + * allow the user code to conditionally enable or disable code based on the USB controller family and allowable + * USB modes. These tokens may be tested against to eliminate code relating to a USB mode which is not enabled for + * the given compilation. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __USBMODE_H__ +#define __USBMODE_H__ + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + #if defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Indicates that the target AVR microcontroller belongs to the Series 2 AVR8 USB controller + * (i.e. AT90USBxxx2 or ATMEGAxxU2) when defined. + */ + #define USB_SERIES_2_AVR + + /** Indicates that the target AVR microcontroller belongs to the Series 4 AVR8 USB controller + * (i.e. ATMEGAxxU4) when defined. + */ + #define USB_SERIES_4_AVR + + /** Indicates that the target AVR microcontroller belongs to the Series 6 AVR8 USB controller + * (i.e. AT90USBxxx6) when defined. + */ + #define USB_SERIES_6_AVR + + /** Indicates that the target AVR microcontroller belongs to the Series 7 AVR8 USB controller + * (i.e. AT90USBxxx7) when defined. + */ + #define USB_SERIES_7_AVR + + /** Indicates that the target AVR microcontroller belongs to the AVR32 UC3A0 Series USB controller + * (i.e. AT32UC3A0*) when defined. + */ + #define USB_SERIES_UC3A0_AVR + + /** Indicates that the target AVR microcontroller belongs to the AVR32 UC3A1 Series USB controller + * (i.e. AT32UC3A1*) when defined. + */ + #define USB_SERIES_UC3A1_AVR + + /** Indicates that the target AVR microcontroller belongs to the AVR32 UC3A3 Series USB controller + * (i.e. AT32UC3A3*) when defined. + */ + #define USB_SERIES_UC3A3_AVR + + /** Indicates that the target AVR microcontroller belongs to the AVR32 UC3A4 Series USB controller + * (i.e. AT32UC3A4*) when defined. + */ + #define USB_SERIES_UC3A4_AVR + + /** Indicates that the target AVR microcontroller belongs to the AVR32 UC3B0 Series USB controller + * (i.e. AT32UC3B0*) when defined. + */ + #define USB_SERIES_UC3B0_AVR + + /** Indicates that the target AVR microcontroller belongs to the AVR32 UC3B1 Series USB controller + * (i.e. AT32UC3B1*) when defined. + */ + #define USB_SERIES_UC3B1_AVR + + /** Indicates that the target AVR microcontroller belongs to the XMEGA A1U Series USB controller + * (i.e. ATXMEGA*A1U) when defined. + */ + #define USB_SERIES_A1U_XMEGA + + /** Indicates that the target AVR microcontroller belongs to the XMEGA A3U Series USB controller + * (i.e. ATXMEGA*A3U) when defined. + */ + #define USB_SERIES_A3U_XMEGA + + /** Indicates that the target AVR microcontroller belongs to the XMEGA A4U Series USB controller + * (i.e. ATXMEGA*A4U) when defined. + */ + #define USB_SERIES_A4U_XMEGA + + /** Indicates that the target AVR microcontroller belongs to the XMEGA B1 Series USB controller + * (i.e. ATXMEGA*B1) when defined. + */ + #define USB_SERIES_B1_XMEGA + + /** Indicates that the target AVR microcontroller belongs to the XMEGA B3 Series USB controller + * (i.e. ATXMEGA*B3) when defined. + */ + #define USB_SERIES_B3_XMEGA + + /** Indicates that the target AVR microcontroller belongs to the XMEGA C3 Series USB controller + * (i.e. ATXMEGA*C3) when defined. + */ + #define USB_SERIES_C3_XMEGA + + /** Indicates that the target AVR microcontroller belongs to the XMEGA C4 Series USB controller + * (i.e. ATXMEGA*C4) when defined. + */ + #define USB_SERIES_C4_XMEGA + + /** Indicates that the target microcontroller and compilation settings allow for the + * target to be configured in USB Device mode when defined. + */ + #define USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + + /** Indicates that the target microcontroller and compilation settings allow for the + * target to be configured in USB Host mode when defined. + */ + #define USB_CAN_BE_HOST + + /** Indicates that the target microcontroller and compilation settings allow for the + * target to be configured in either USB Device or Host mode when defined. + */ + #define USB_CAN_BE_BOTH + #else + /* Macros: */ + #if (defined(__AVR_AT90USB162__) || defined(__AVR_AT90USB82__) || \ + defined(__AVR_ATmega32U2__) || defined(__AVR_ATmega16U2__) || defined(__AVR_ATmega8U2__)) + #define USB_SERIES_2_AVR + #define USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + #elif (defined(__AVR_ATmega32U4__) || defined(__AVR_ATmega16U4__)) + #define USB_SERIES_4_AVR + #define USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + #elif (defined(__AVR_AT90USB646__) || defined(__AVR_AT90USB1286__)) + #define USB_SERIES_6_AVR + #define USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + #elif (defined(__AVR_AT90USB647__) || defined(__AVR_AT90USB1287__)) + #define USB_SERIES_7_AVR + #define USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + #define USB_CAN_BE_HOST + #elif (defined(__AVR32_UC3A0512__) || defined(__AVR32_UC3A0256__) || \ + defined(__AVR32_UC3A0128__) || defined(__AVR32_UC3A064__)) + #define USB_SERIES_UC3A0_AVR32 + #define USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + #define USB_CAN_BE_HOST + #elif (defined(__AVR32_UC3A1512__) || defined(__AVR32_UC3A1256__) || \ + defined(__AVR32_UC3A1128__) || defined(__AVR32_UC3A164__)) + #define USB_SERIES_UC3A1_AVR32 + #define USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + #define USB_CAN_BE_HOST + #elif (defined(__AVR32_UC3A3256__) || defined(__AVR32_UC3A3256S__) || \ + defined(__AVR32_UC3A3128__) || defined(__AVR32_UC3A3128S__) || \ + defined(__AVR32_UC3A364__) || defined(__AVR32_UC3A364S__)) + #define USB_SERIES_UC3A3_AVR32 + #define USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + #define USB_CAN_BE_HOST + #elif (defined(__AVR32_UC3A4256__) || defined(__AVR32_UC3A4256S__) || \ + defined(__AVR32_UC3A4128__) || defined(__AVR32_UC3A4128S__) || \ + defined(__AVR32_UC3A464__) || defined(__AVR32_UC3A464S__)) + #define USB_SERIES_UC3A4_AVR32 + #define USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + #define USB_CAN_BE_HOST + #elif (defined(__AVR32_UC3B0512__) || defined(__AVR32_UC3B0256__) || \ + defined(__AVR32_UC3B0128__) || defined(__AVR32_UC3B064__)) + #define USB_SERIES_UC3B0_AVR32 + #define USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + #define USB_CAN_BE_HOST + #elif (defined(__AVR32_UC3B1512__) || defined(__AVR32_UC3B1256__) || \ + defined(__AVR32_UC3B1128__) || defined(__AVR32_UC3B164__)) + #define USB_SERIES_UC3B1_AVR32 + #define USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + #define USB_CAN_BE_HOST + #elif (defined(__AVR_ATxmega128A1U__) || defined(__AVR_ATxmega64A1U__)) + #define USB_SERIES_A1U_XMEGA + #define USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + #elif (defined(__AVR_ATxmega64A3U__) || defined(__AVR_ATxmega128A3U__) || \ + defined(__AVR_ATxmega192A3U__) || defined(__AVR_ATxmega256A3U__)) + #define USB_SERIES_A3U_XMEGA + #define USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + #elif (defined(__AVR_ATxmega256A3BU__)) + #define USB_SERIES_A3BU_XMEGA + #define USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + #elif (defined(__AVR_ATxmega16A4U__) || defined(__AVR_ATxmega32A4U__) || \ + defined(__AVR_ATxmega64A4U__) || defined(__AVR_ATxmega128A4U__)) + #define USB_SERIES_A4U_XMEGA + #define USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + #elif (defined(__AVR_ATxmega128B1__) || defined(__AVR_ATxmega64B1__)) + #define USB_SERIES_B1_XMEGA + #define USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + #elif (defined(__AVR_ATxmega128B3__) || defined(__AVR_ATxmega64B3__)) + #define USB_SERIES_B3_XMEGA + #define USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + #elif (defined(__AVR_ATxmega128C3__) || defined(__AVR_ATxmega64C3__) || \ + defined(__AVR_ATxmega192C3__) || defined(__AVR_ATxmega256C3__) || \ + defined(__AVR_ATxmega384C3__)) + #define USB_SERIES_C3_XMEGA + #define USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + #elif (defined(__AVR_ATxmega16C4__) || defined(__AVR_ATxmega32C4__)) + #define USB_SERIES_C4_XMEGA + #define USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + #endif + + #if (defined(USB_HOST_ONLY) && defined(USB_DEVICE_ONLY)) + #error USB_HOST_ONLY and USB_DEVICE_ONLY are mutually exclusive. + #elif defined(USB_HOST_ONLY) + #if !defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + #error USB_HOST_ONLY is not available for the currently selected microcontroller model. + #else + #undef USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE + #endif + #elif defined(USB_DEVICE_ONLY) + #if !defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + #error USB_DEVICE_ONLY is not available for the currently selected microcontroller model. + #else + #undef USB_CAN_BE_HOST + #endif + #endif + + #if (defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) && defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST)) + #define USB_CAN_BE_BOTH + #endif + + #if (!defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) && !defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST)) + #error The currently selected device, USB mode or architecture is not supported. + #endif + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/USBTask.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/USBTask.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..329ff4a272 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/USBTask.c @@ -0,0 +1,89 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USBTASK_C +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "USBTask.h" + +volatile bool USB_IsInitialized; +USB_Request_Header_t USB_ControlRequest; + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) && !defined(HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR) +volatile uint8_t USB_HostState; +#endif + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) && !defined(DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR) +volatile uint8_t USB_DeviceState; +#endif + +void USB_USBTask(void) +{ + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + if (USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Device) + USB_DeviceTask(); + else if (USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Host) + USB_HostTask(); + #elif defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + USB_HostTask(); + #elif defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + USB_DeviceTask(); + #endif +} + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) +static void USB_DeviceTask(void) +{ + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + + uint8_t PrevEndpoint = Endpoint_GetCurrentEndpoint(); + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP); + + if (Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived()) + USB_Device_ProcessControlRequest(); + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(PrevEndpoint); +} +#endif + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) +static void USB_HostTask(void) +{ + uint8_t PrevPipe = Pipe_GetCurrentPipe(); + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + USB_Host_ProcessNextHostState(); + + Pipe_SelectPipe(PrevPipe); +} +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/USBTask.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/USBTask.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..77cee65815 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/USBTask.h @@ -0,0 +1,200 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Main USB service task management. + * + * This file contains the function definitions required for the main USB service task, which must be called + * from the user application to ensure that the USB connection to or from a connected USB device is maintained. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +#ifndef __USBTASK_H__ +#define __USBTASK_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "USBMode.h" + #include "USBController.h" + #include "Events.h" + #include "StdRequestType.h" + #include "StdDescriptors.h" + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + #include "DeviceStandardReq.h" + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + #include "HostStandardReq.h" + #endif + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Global Variables: */ + /** Indicates if the USB interface is currently initialized but not necessarily connected to a host + * or device (i.e. if \ref USB_Init() has been run). If this is false, all other library globals related + * to the USB driver are invalid. + * + * \attention This variable should be treated as read-only in the user application, and never manually + * changed in value. + * + * \ingroup Group_USBManagement + */ + extern volatile bool USB_IsInitialized; + + /** Structure containing the last received Control request when in Device mode (for use in user-applications + * inside of the \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event, or for filling up with a control request to + * issue when in Host mode before calling \ref USB_Host_SendControlRequest(). + * + * \note The contents of this structure is automatically endian-corrected for the current CPU architecture. + * + * \ingroup Group_USBManagement + */ + extern USB_Request_Header_t USB_ControlRequest; + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #if !defined(HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Indicates the current host state machine state. When in host mode, this indicates the state + * via one of the values of the \ref USB_Host_States_t enum values. + * + * This value should not be altered by the user application as it is handled automatically by the + * library. + * + * To reduce program size and speed up checks of this global on the AVR8 architecture, it can be + * placed into one of the AVR's \c GPIOR hardware registers instead of RAM by defining the + * \c HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR token to a value between 0 and 2 in the project makefile and passing it to + * the compiler via the -D switch. When defined, the corresponding GPIOR register should not be used + * in the user application except implicitly via the library APIs. + * + * \note This global is only present if the user application can be a USB host. + * + * \see \ref USB_Host_States_t for a list of possible device states. + * + * \ingroup Group_Host + */ + extern volatile uint8_t USB_HostState; + #else + #define USB_HostState CONCAT_EXPANDED(GPIOR, HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR) + #endif + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #if !defined(DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Indicates the current device state machine state. When in device mode, this indicates the state + * via one of the values of the \ref USB_Device_States_t enum values. + * + * This value should not be altered by the user application as it is handled automatically by the + * library. The only exception to this rule is if the NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT token is used + * (see \ref EVENT_USB_Device_Connect() and \ref EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect() events). + * + * To reduce program size and speed up checks of this global on the AVR8 architecture, it can be + * placed into one of the AVR's \c GPIOR hardware registers instead of RAM by defining the + * \c DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR token to a value between 0 and 2 in the project makefile and passing it to + * the compiler via the -D switch. When defined, the corresponding GPIOR register should not be used + * in the user application except implicitly via the library APIs. + * + * \attention This variable should be treated as read-only in the user application, and never manually + * changed in value except in the circumstances outlined above. + * + * \note This global is only present if the user application can be a USB device. + * \n\n + * + * \see \ref USB_Device_States_t for a list of possible device states. + * + * \ingroup Group_Device + */ + extern volatile uint8_t USB_DeviceState; + #else + #define USB_DeviceState CONCAT_EXPANDED(GPIOR, DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR) + #endif + #endif + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** This is the main USB management task. The USB driver requires this task to be executed + * continuously when the USB system is active (device attached in host mode, or attached to a host + * in device mode) in order to manage USB communications. This task may be executed inside an RTOS, + * fast timer ISR or the main user application loop. + * + * The USB task must be serviced within 30ms while in device mode, or within 1ms while in host mode. + * The task may be serviced at all times, or (for minimum CPU consumption): + * + * - In device mode, it may be disabled at start-up, enabled on the firing of the \ref EVENT_USB_Device_Connect() + * event and disabled again on the firing of the \ref EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect() event. + * + * - In host mode, it may be disabled at start-up, enabled on the firing of the \ref EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached() + * event and disabled again on the firing of the \ref EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete() or + * \ref EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed() events. + * + * If in device mode (only), the control endpoint can instead be managed via interrupts entirely by the library + * by defining the INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT token and passing it to the compiler via the -D switch. + * + * \see \ref Group_Events for more information on the USB events. + * + * \ingroup Group_USBManagement + */ + void USB_USBTask(void); + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USBTASK_C) + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + static void USB_HostTask(void); + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + static void USB_DeviceTask(void); + #endif + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + #define HOST_TASK_NONBLOCK_WAIT(Duration, NextState) do { USB_HostState = HOST_STATE_WaitForDevice; \ + WaitMSRemaining = (Duration); \ + PostWaitState = (NextState); } while (0) + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Device_XMEGA.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Device_XMEGA.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..470e128b64 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Device_XMEGA.c @@ -0,0 +1,49 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + +#include "../Device.h" + +void USB_Device_SendRemoteWakeup(void) +{ + USB.CTRLB |= USB_RWAKEUP_bm; +} + +#endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Device_XMEGA.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Device_XMEGA.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..759ff350b3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Device_XMEGA.h @@ -0,0 +1,266 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Device definitions for the AVR XMEGA microcontrollers. + * \copydetails Group_Device_XMEGA + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_Device + * \defgroup Group_Device_XMEGA Device Management (XMEGA) + * \brief USB Device definitions for the AVR XMEGA microcontrollers. + * + * Architecture specific USB Device definitions for the Atmel AVR XMEGA microcontrollers. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __USBDEVICE_XMEGA_H__ +#define __USBDEVICE_XMEGA_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../USBController.h" + #include "../StdDescriptors.h" + #include "../USBInterrupt.h" + #include "../Endpoint.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + #if (defined(USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS) && defined(USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS)) + #error USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS and USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS are mutually exclusive. + #endif + + #if (defined(USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS) && defined(USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS)) + #error USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS and USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS are mutually exclusive. + #endif + + #if (defined(USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS) && defined(USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS)) + #error USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS and USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS are mutually exclusive. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** \name USB Device Mode Option Masks */ + //@{ + /** Mask for the Options parameter of the \ref USB_Init() function. This indicates that the + * USB interface should be initialized in low speed (1.5Mb/s) mode. + * + * \note Low Speed mode is not available on all USB AVR models. + * \n + * + * \note Restrictions apply on the number, size and type of endpoints which can be used + * when running in low speed mode - refer to the USB 2.0 specification. + */ + #define USB_DEVICE_OPT_LOWSPEED (1 << 0) + + #if (F_USB > 6000000) + /** Mask for the Options parameter of the \ref USB_Init() function. This indicates that the + * USB interface should be initialized in full speed (12Mb/s) mode. + */ + #define USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED (0 << 0) + #endif + //@} + + #if (!defined(NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + /** String descriptor index for the device's unique serial number string descriptor within the device. + * This unique serial number is used by the host to associate resources to the device (such as drivers or COM port + * number allocations) to a device regardless of the port it is plugged in to on the host. Some microcontrollers contain + * a unique serial number internally, and setting the device descriptors serial number string index to this value + * will cause it to use the internal serial number. + * + * On unsupported devices, this will evaluate to \ref NO_DESCRIPTOR and so will force the host to create a pseudo-serial + * number for the device. + */ + #define USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL 0xDC + + /** Length of the device's unique internal serial number, in bits, if present on the selected microcontroller + * model. + */ + #define INTERNAL_SERIAL_LENGTH_BITS (8 * (1 + (offsetof(NVM_PROD_SIGNATURES_t, COORDY1) - offsetof(NVM_PROD_SIGNATURES_t, LOTNUM0)))) + + /** Start address of the internal serial number, in the appropriate address space, if present on the selected microcontroller + * model. + */ + #define INTERNAL_SERIAL_START_ADDRESS offsetof(NVM_PROD_SIGNATURES_t, LOTNUM0) + #else + #define USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL NO_DESCRIPTOR + + #define INTERNAL_SERIAL_LENGTH_BITS 0 + #define INTERNAL_SERIAL_START_ADDRESS 0 + #endif + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Sends a Remote Wakeup request to the host. This signals to the host that the device should + * be taken out of suspended mode, and communications should resume. + * + * Typically, this is implemented so that HID devices (mice, keyboards, etc.) can wake up the + * host computer when the host has suspended all USB devices to enter a low power state. + * + * \note This function should only be used if the device has indicated to the host that it + * supports the Remote Wakeup feature in the device descriptors, and should only be + * issued if the host is currently allowing remote wakeup events from the device (i.e., + * the \ref USB_Device_RemoteWakeupEnabled flag is set). When the \c NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP + * compile time option is used, this function is unavailable. + * \n\n + * + * \note The USB clock must be running for this function to operate. If the stack is initialized with + * the \ref USB_OPT_MANUAL_PLL option enabled, the user must ensure that the PLL is running + * before attempting to call this function. + * + * \see \ref Group_StdDescriptors for more information on the RMWAKEUP feature and device descriptors. + */ + void USB_Device_SendRemoteWakeup(void); + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Returns the current USB frame number, when in device mode. Every millisecond the USB bus is active (i.e. enumerated to a host) + * the frame number is incremented by one. + * + * \return Current USB frame number from the USB controller. + */ + static inline uint16_t USB_Device_GetFrameNumber(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint16_t USB_Device_GetFrameNumber(void) + { + return ((USB_EndpointTable_t*)USB.EPPTR)->FrameNum; + } + + #if !defined(NO_SOF_EVENTS) + /** Enables the device mode Start Of Frame events. When enabled, this causes the + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame() event to fire once per millisecond, synchronized to the USB bus, + * at the start of each USB frame when enumerated in device mode. + * + * \note This function is not available when the \c NO_SOF_EVENTS compile time token is defined. + */ + static inline void USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(void) + { + USB.INTCTRLA |= USB_SOFIE_bm; + } + + /** Disables the device mode Start Of Frame events. When disabled, this stops the firing of the + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame() event when enumerated in device mode. + * + * \note This function is not available when the \c NO_SOF_EVENTS compile time token is defined. + */ + static inline void USB_Device_DisableSOFEvents(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Device_DisableSOFEvents(void) + { + USB.INTCTRLA &= ~USB_SOFIE_bm; + } + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Inline Functions: */ + static inline void USB_Device_SetLowSpeed(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Device_SetLowSpeed(void) + { + USB.CTRLA &= ~USB_SPEED_bm; + } + + static inline void USB_Device_SetFullSpeed(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Device_SetFullSpeed(void) + { + USB.CTRLA |= USB_SPEED_bm; + } + + static inline void USB_Device_SetDeviceAddress(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Device_SetDeviceAddress(const uint8_t Address) + { + (void)Address; + + /* No implementation for XMEGA architecture */ + } + + static inline void USB_Device_EnableDeviceAddress(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Device_EnableDeviceAddress(const uint8_t Address) + { + USB.ADDR = Address; + } + + static inline bool USB_Device_IsAddressSet(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline bool USB_Device_IsAddressSet(void) + { + return ((USB.ADDR != 0) ? true : false); + } + + static inline void USB_Device_GetSerialString(uint16_t* const UnicodeString) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + static inline void USB_Device_GetSerialString(uint16_t* const UnicodeString) + { + uint_reg_t CurrentGlobalInt = GetGlobalInterruptMask(); + GlobalInterruptDisable(); + + uint8_t SigReadAddress = INTERNAL_SERIAL_START_ADDRESS; + + for (uint8_t SerialCharNum = 0; SerialCharNum < (INTERNAL_SERIAL_LENGTH_BITS / 4); SerialCharNum++) + { + uint8_t SerialByte; + + NVM.CMD = NVM_CMD_READ_CALIB_ROW_gc; + SerialByte = pgm_read_byte(SigReadAddress); + NVM.CMD = 0; + + if (SerialCharNum & 0x01) + { + SerialByte >>= 4; + SigReadAddress++; + } + + SerialByte &= 0x0F; + + UnicodeString[SerialCharNum] = cpu_to_le16((SerialByte >= 10) ? + (('A' - 10) + SerialByte) : ('0' + SerialByte)); + } + + SetGlobalInterruptMask(CurrentGlobalInt); + } + + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/EndpointStream_XMEGA.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/EndpointStream_XMEGA.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6413281708 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/EndpointStream_XMEGA.c @@ -0,0 +1,275 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + +#include "EndpointStream_XMEGA.h" + +#if !defined(CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE) +uint8_t Endpoint_Discard_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + uint16_t BytesInTransfer = 0; + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + Length -= *BytesProcessed; + + while (Length) + { + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + *BytesProcessed += BytesInTransfer; + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + } + else + { + Endpoint_Discard_8(); + + Length--; + BytesInTransfer++; + } + } + + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +uint8_t Endpoint_Null_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) +{ + uint8_t ErrorCode; + uint16_t BytesInTransfer = 0; + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + Length -= *BytesProcessed; + + while (Length) + { + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + *BytesProcessed += BytesInTransfer; + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + } + else + { + Endpoint_Write_8(0); + + Length--; + BytesInTransfer++; + } + } + + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +/* The following abuses the C preprocessor in order to copy-paste common code with slight alterations, + * so that the code needs to be written once. It is a crude form of templating to reduce code maintenance. */ + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearIN() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(*BufferPtr) +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearIN() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(*BufferPtr) +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE void* +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearOUT() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) *BufferPtr = Endpoint_Read_8() +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_Stream_BE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE void* +#define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearOUT() +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) *BufferPtr = Endpoint_Read_8() +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + +#if defined(ARCH_HAS_FLASH_ADDRESS_SPACE) + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_PStream_LE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* + #define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearIN() + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(pgm_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_PStream_BE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* + #define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearIN() + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(pgm_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" +#endif + +#if defined(ARCH_HAS_EEPROM_ADDRESS_SPACE) + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_EStream_LE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* + #define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearIN() + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(eeprom_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_EStream_BE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const void* + #define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearIN() + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(eeprom_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_EStream_LE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE void* + #define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearOUT() + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) eeprom_update_byte(BufferPtr, Endpoint_Read_8()) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_EStream_BE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE void* + #define TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT() Endpoint_ClearOUT() + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) eeprom_update_byte(BufferPtr, Endpoint_Read_8()) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c" +#endif + +#endif + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(*BufferPtr) +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_BE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(*BufferPtr) +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) *BufferPtr = Endpoint_Read_8() +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c" + +#define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_BE +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) +#define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount +#define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) *BufferPtr = Endpoint_Read_8() +#include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c" + +#if defined(ARCH_HAS_FLASH_ADDRESS_SPACE) + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Control_PStream_LE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(pgm_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Control_PStream_BE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(pgm_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c" +#endif + +#if defined(ARCH_HAS_EEPROM_ADDRESS_SPACE) + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Control_EStream_LE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(eeprom_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Write_Control_EStream_BE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) Endpoint_Write_8(eeprom_read_byte(BufferPtr)) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_Control_EStream_LE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) 0 + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr += Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) eeprom_update_byte(BufferPtr, Endpoint_Read_8()) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c" + + #define TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME Endpoint_Read_Control_EStream_BE + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length) (Length - 1) + #define TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(BufferPtr, Amount) BufferPtr -= Amount + #define TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(BufferPtr) eeprom_update_byte(BufferPtr, Endpoint_Read_8()) + #include "Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c" +#endif + +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/EndpointStream_XMEGA.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/EndpointStream_XMEGA.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3c094da49c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/EndpointStream_XMEGA.h @@ -0,0 +1,658 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Endpoint data stream transmission and reception management for the AVR XMEGA microcontrollers. + * \copydetails Group_EndpointStreamRW_XMEGA + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_EndpointStreamRW + * \defgroup Group_EndpointStreamRW_XMEGA Read/Write of Multi-Byte Streams (XMEGA) + * \brief Endpoint data stream transmission and reception management for the Atmel AVR XMEGA architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing of data streams from + * and to endpoints. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __ENDPOINT_STREAM_XMEGA_H__ +#define __ENDPOINT_STREAM_XMEGA_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../USBMode.h" + #include "../USBTask.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** \name Stream functions for null data */ + //@{ + + /** Reads and discards the given number of bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank, + * discarding fully read packets from the host as needed. The last packet is not automatically + * discarded once the remaining bytes has been read; the user is responsible for manually + * discarding the last packet from the host via the \ref Endpoint_ClearOUT() macro. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, + * failing or succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid + * storage location, the transfer will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time + * the endpoint bank becomes empty while there is still data to process (and after the current + * packet has been acknowledged) the BytesProcessed location will be updated with the total number + * of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed + * in the user code - to continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters + * and it will resume until the BytesProcessed value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Discard_Stream(512, NULL)) != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Discard_Stream(512, &BytesProcessed)) == ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note This routine should not be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to discard via the currently selected endpoint. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Discard_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed); + + /** Writes a given number of zeroed bytes to the currently selected endpoint's bank, sending + * full packets to the host as needed. The last packet is not automatically sent once the + * remaining bytes have been written; the user is responsible for manually sending the last + * packet to the host via the \ref Endpoint_ClearIN() macro. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, + * failing or succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid + * storage location, the transfer will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time + * the endpoint bank becomes full while there is still data to process (and after the current + * packet transmission has been initiated) the BytesProcessed location will be updated with the + * total number of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed + * in the user code - to continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters + * and it will resume until the BytesProcessed value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Null_Stream(512, NULL)) != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Null_Stream(512, &BytesProcessed)) == ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note This routine should not be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \param[in] Length Number of zero bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Null_Stream(uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed); + + //@} + + /** \name Stream functions for RAM source/destination data */ + //@{ + + /** Writes the given number of bytes to the endpoint from the given buffer in little endian, + * sending full packets to the host as needed. The last packet filled is not automatically sent; + * the user is responsible for manually sending the last written packet to the host via the + * \ref Endpoint_ClearIN() macro. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, + * failing or succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid + * storage location, the transfer will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time + * the endpoint bank becomes full while there is still data to process (and after the current + * packet transmission has been initiated) the BytesProcessed location will be updated with the + * total number of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed + * in the user code - to continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters + * and it will resume until the BytesProcessed value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * NULL)) != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * &BytesProcessed)) == ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note This routine should not be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Writes the given number of bytes to the endpoint from the given buffer in big endian, + * sending full packets to the host as needed. The last packet filled is not automatically sent; + * the user is responsible for manually sending the last written packet to the host via the + * \ref Endpoint_ClearIN() macro. + * + * \note This routine should not be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads the given number of bytes from the endpoint from the given buffer in little endian, + * discarding fully read packets from the host as needed. The last packet is not automatically + * discarded once the remaining bytes has been read; the user is responsible for manually + * discarding the last packet from the host via the \ref Endpoint_ClearOUT() macro. + * + * If the BytesProcessed parameter is \c NULL, the entire stream transfer is attempted at once, + * failing or succeeding as a single unit. If the BytesProcessed parameter points to a valid + * storage location, the transfer will instead be performed as a series of chunks. Each time + * the endpoint bank becomes empty while there is still data to process (and after the current + * packet has been acknowledged) the BytesProcessed location will be updated with the total number + * of bytes processed in the stream, and the function will exit with an error code of + * \ref ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer. This allows for any abort checking to be performed + * in the user code - to continue the transfer, call the function again with identical parameters + * and it will resume until the BytesProcessed value reaches the total transfer length. + * + * <b>Single Stream Transfer Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * + * if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * NULL)) != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * <b>Partial Stream Transfers Example:</b> + * \code + * uint8_t DataStream[512]; + * uint8_t ErrorCode; + * uint16_t BytesProcessed; + * + * BytesProcessed = 0; + * while ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(DataStream, sizeof(DataStream), + * &BytesProcessed)) == ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer) + * { + * // Stream not yet complete - do other actions here, abort if required + * } + * + * if (ErrorCode != ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError) + * { + * // Stream failed to complete - check ErrorCode here + * } + * \endcode + * + * \note This routine should not be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads the given number of bytes from the endpoint from the given buffer in big endian, + * discarding fully read packets from the host as needed. The last packet is not automatically + * discarded once the remaining bytes has been read; the user is responsible for manually + * discarding the last packet from the host via the \ref Endpoint_ClearOUT() macro. + * + * \note This routine should not be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_Stream_BE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Writes the given number of bytes to the CONTROL type endpoint from the given buffer in little endian, + * sending full packets to the host as needed. The host OUT acknowledgement is not automatically cleared + * in both failure and success states; the user is responsible for manually clearing the status OUT packet + * to finalize the transfer's status stage via the \ref Endpoint_ClearOUT() macro. + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Writes the given number of bytes to the CONTROL type endpoint from the given buffer in big endian, + * sending full packets to the host as needed. The host OUT acknowledgement is not automatically cleared + * in both failure and success states; the user is responsible for manually clearing the status OUT packet + * to finalize the transfer's status stage via the \ref Endpoint_ClearOUT() macro. + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_BE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads the given number of bytes from the CONTROL endpoint from the given buffer in little endian, + * discarding fully read packets from the host as needed. The device IN acknowledgement is not + * automatically sent after success or failure states; the user is responsible for manually sending the + * status IN packet to finalize the transfer's status stage via the \ref Endpoint_ClearIN() macro. + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Reads the given number of bytes from the CONTROL endpoint from the given buffer in big endian, + * discarding fully read packets from the host as needed. The device IN acknowledgement is not + * automatically sent after success or failure states; the user is responsible for manually sending the + * status IN packet to finalize the transfer's status stage via the \ref Endpoint_ClearIN() macro. + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_BE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + //@} + + /** \name Stream functions for EEPROM source/destination data */ + //@{ + + /** EEPROM buffer source version of \ref Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(). + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_EStream_LE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** EEPROM buffer source version of \ref Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE(). + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_EStream_BE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** EEPROM buffer destination version of \ref Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(). + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to, located in EEPROM memory space. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_EStream_LE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** EEPROM buffer destination version of \ref Endpoint_Read_Stream_BE(). + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to, located in EEPROM memory space. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be read at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_EStream_BE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** EEPROM buffer source version of Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE. + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * \n\n + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Control_EStream_LE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** EEPROM buffer source version of \ref Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_BE(). + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * \n\n + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Control_EStream_BE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** EEPROM buffer source version of \ref Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE(). + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * \n\n + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_Control_EStream_LE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** EEPROM buffer source version of \ref Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_BE(). + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * \n\n + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[out] Buffer Pointer to the destination data buffer to write to. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to send via the currently selected endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_Control_EStream_BE(void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + //@} + + /** \name Stream functions for PROGMEM source/destination data */ + //@{ + + /** FLASH buffer source version of \ref Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(). + * + * \pre The FLASH data must be located in the first 64KB of FLASH for this function to work correctly. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_PStream_LE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** FLASH buffer source version of \ref Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE(). + * + * \pre The FLASH data must be located in the first 64KB of FLASH for this function to work correctly. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * \param[in] BytesProcessed Pointer to a location where the total number of bytes processed in the current + * transaction should be updated, \c NULL if the entire stream should be written at once. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_Stream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_PStream_BE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** FLASH buffer source version of \ref Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(). + * + * \pre The FLASH data must be located in the first 64KB of FLASH for this function to work correctly. + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * \n\n + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Control_PStream_LE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** FLASH buffer source version of \ref Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_BE(). + * + * \pre The FLASH data must be located in the first 64KB of FLASH for this function to work correctly. + * + * \note This function automatically sends the last packet in the data stage of the transaction; when the + * function returns, the user is responsible for clearing the <b>status</b> stage of the transaction. + * Note that the status stage packet is sent or received in the opposite direction of the data flow. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine should only be used on CONTROL type endpoints. + * \n\n + * + * \warning Unlike the standard stream read/write commands, the control stream commands cannot be chained + * together; i.e. the entire stream data must be read or written at the one time. + * + * \param[in] Buffer Pointer to the source data buffer to read from. + * \param[in] Length Number of bytes to read for the currently selected endpoint into the buffer. + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_ControlStream_RW_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Write_Control_PStream_BE(const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + //@} + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Endpoint_XMEGA.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Endpoint_XMEGA.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..470f57ea29 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Endpoint_XMEGA.c @@ -0,0 +1,268 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + +#include "../Endpoint.h" + +#if !defined(FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE) +uint8_t USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize = ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP_DEFAULT_SIZE; +#endif + +Endpoint_FIFOPair_t USB_Endpoint_FIFOs[ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS]; + +volatile uint8_t USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint; +volatile USB_EP_t* USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle; +volatile Endpoint_FIFO_t* USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO; + +bool Endpoint_IsINReady(void) +{ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint | ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + return ((USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->STATUS & USB_EP_BUSNACK0_bm) ? true : false); +} + +bool Endpoint_IsOUTReceived(void) +{ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint & ~ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + if (USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->STATUS & USB_EP_TRNCOMPL0_bm) + { + USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Length = USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->CNT; + return true; + } + + return false; +} + +bool Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived(void) +{ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint & ~ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + if (USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->STATUS & USB_EP_SETUP_bm) + { + USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Length = USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->CNT; + return true; + } + + return false; +} + +void Endpoint_ClearSETUP(void) +{ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint & ~ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->STATUS &= ~(USB_EP_SETUP_bm | USB_EP_TRNCOMPL0_bm | USB_EP_BUSNACK0_bm | USB_EP_OVF_bm); + USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->STATUS |= USB_EP_TOGGLE_bm; + USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Position = 0; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint | ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->STATUS |= USB_EP_TOGGLE_bm; + USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Position = 0; +} + +void Endpoint_ClearIN(void) +{ + USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->CNT = USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Position; + USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->STATUS &= ~(USB_EP_TRNCOMPL0_bm | USB_EP_BUSNACK0_bm | USB_EP_OVF_bm); + USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Position = 0; +} + +void Endpoint_ClearOUT(void) +{ + USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->STATUS &= ~(USB_EP_TRNCOMPL0_bm | USB_EP_BUSNACK0_bm | USB_EP_OVF_bm); + USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Position = 0; +} + +void Endpoint_StallTransaction(void) +{ + USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->CTRL |= USB_EP_STALL_bm; + + if ((USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->CTRL & USB_EP_TYPE_gm) == USB_EP_TYPE_CONTROL_gc) + { + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint ^ ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->CTRL |= USB_EP_STALL_bm; + } +} + +uint8_t Endpoint_Read_8(void) +{ + return USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Data[USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Position++]; +} + +void Endpoint_Write_8(const uint8_t Data) +{ + USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Data[USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Position++] = Data; +} + +void Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(const uint8_t Address) +{ + uint8_t EndpointNumber = (Address & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK); + + USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint = Address; + + Endpoint_FIFOPair_t* EndpointFIFOPair = &USB_Endpoint_FIFOs[EndpointNumber]; + USB_EndpointTable_t* EndpointTable = (USB_EndpointTable_t*)USB.EPPTR; + + if (Address & ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + { + USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO = &EndpointFIFOPair->IN; + USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle = &EndpointTable->Endpoints[EndpointNumber].IN; + } + else + { + USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO = &EndpointFIFOPair->OUT; + USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle = &EndpointTable->Endpoints[EndpointNumber].OUT; + } +} + +bool Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(const USB_Endpoint_Table_t* const Table, + const uint8_t Entries) +{ + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < Entries; i++) + { + if (!(Table[i].Address)) + continue; + + if (!(Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(Table[i].Address, Table[i].Type, Table[i].Size, Table[i].Banks))) + { + return false; + } + } + + return true; +} + +bool Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint_PRV(const uint8_t Address, + const uint8_t Config, + const uint8_t Size) +{ + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(Address); + + USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->CTRL = 0; + USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->STATUS = (Address & ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) ? USB_EP_BUSNACK0_bm : 0; + USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->CTRL = Config; + USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->CNT = 0; + USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->DATAPTR = (intptr_t)USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Data; + + USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Length = (Address & ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) ? Size : 0; + USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Position = 0; + + return true; +} + +void Endpoint_ClearEndpoints(void) +{ + for (uint8_t EPNum = 0; EPNum < ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS; EPNum++) + { + ((USB_EndpointTable_t*)USB.EPPTR)->Endpoints[EPNum].IN.CTRL = 0; + ((USB_EndpointTable_t*)USB.EPPTR)->Endpoints[EPNum].OUT.CTRL = 0; + } +} + +void Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(void) +{ + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType & REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST) + { + while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + else + { + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) + { + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return; + } + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } +} + +#if !defined(CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE) +uint8_t Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(void) +{ + #if (USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS < 0xFF) + uint8_t TimeoutMSRem = USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS; + #else + uint16_t TimeoutMSRem = USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS; + #endif + + uint16_t PreviousFrameNumber = USB_Device_GetFrameNumber(); + + for (;;) + { + if (Endpoint_GetEndpointDirection() == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + { + if (Endpoint_IsINReady()) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError; + } + else + { + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError; + } + + uint8_t USB_DeviceState_LCL = USB_DeviceState; + + if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected; + else if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Suspended) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_BusSuspended; + else if (Endpoint_IsStalled()) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_EndpointStalled; + + uint16_t CurrentFrameNumber = USB_Device_GetFrameNumber(); + + if (CurrentFrameNumber != PreviousFrameNumber) + { + PreviousFrameNumber = CurrentFrameNumber; + + if (!(TimeoutMSRem--)) + return ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_Timeout; + } + } +} +#endif + +#endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Endpoint_XMEGA.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Endpoint_XMEGA.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..db7d840d2e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Endpoint_XMEGA.h @@ -0,0 +1,689 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Endpoint definitions for the AVR XMEGA microcontrollers. + * \copydetails Group_EndpointManagement_XMEGA + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_EndpointRW + * \defgroup Group_EndpointRW_XMEGA Endpoint Data Reading and Writing (XMEGA) + * \brief Endpoint data read/write definitions for the Atmel AVR XMEGA architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing from and to endpoints. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW + * \defgroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_XMEGA Read/Write of Primitive Data Types (XMEGA) + * \brief Endpoint primitive read/write definitions for the Atmel AVR XMEGA architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to data reading and writing of primitive data types + * from and to endpoints. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement + * \defgroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_XMEGA Endpoint Packet Management (XMEGA) + * \brief Endpoint packet management definitions for the Atmel AVR XMEGA architecture. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to packet management of endpoints. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_EndpointManagement + * \defgroup Group_EndpointManagement_XMEGA Endpoint Management (XMEGA) + * \brief Endpoint management definitions for the Atmel AVR XMEGA architecture. + * + * Functions, macros and enums related to endpoint management when in USB Device mode. This + * module contains the endpoint management macros, as well as endpoint interrupt and data + * send/receive functions for various data types. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __ENDPOINT_XMEGA_H__ +#define __ENDPOINT_XMEGA_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../USBTask.h" + #include "../USBInterrupt.h" + #include "../USBController.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + #if (!defined(MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX) && !defined(CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE)) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Total number of endpoints (including the default control endpoint at address 0) which may + * be used in the device. Different USB AVR models support different amounts of endpoints, + * this value reflects the maximum number of endpoints for the currently selected AVR model. + */ + #define ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS 16 + #else + #if defined(CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE) + #define ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS 1 + #else + #define ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS (MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX + 1) + #endif + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Type Defines: */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Data[64]; + + uint8_t Length; + uint8_t Position; + } Endpoint_FIFO_t; + + typedef struct + { + Endpoint_FIFO_t OUT; + Endpoint_FIFO_t IN; + } Endpoint_FIFOPair_t; + + /* External Variables: */ + extern Endpoint_FIFOPair_t USB_Endpoint_FIFOs[ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS]; + extern volatile uint8_t USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint; + extern volatile USB_EP_t* USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle; + extern volatile Endpoint_FIFO_t* USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO; + + /* Inline Functions: */ + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_BytesToEPSizeMask(const uint16_t Bytes) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_CONST + ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_BytesToEPSizeMask(const uint16_t Bytes) + { + uint8_t MaskVal = 0; + uint16_t CheckBytes = 8; + + while (CheckBytes < Bytes) + { + MaskVal++; + CheckBytes <<= 1; + } + + return (MaskVal << USB_EP_BUFSIZE_gp); + } + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + bool Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint_PRV(const uint8_t Address, + const uint8_t Config, + const uint8_t Size); + void Endpoint_ClearEndpoints(void); + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + #if (!defined(FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + /** Default size of the default control endpoint's bank, until altered by the control endpoint bank size + * value in the device descriptor. Not available if the \c FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE token is defined. + */ + #define ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP_DEFAULT_SIZE 8 + #endif + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible error return codes of the \ref Endpoint_WaitUntilReady() function. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointRW_XMEGA + */ + enum Endpoint_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t + { + ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError = 0, /**< Endpoint is ready for next packet, no error. */ + ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_EndpointStalled = 1, /**< The endpoint was stalled during the stream + * transfer by the host or device. + */ + ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_DeviceDisconnected = 2, /**< Device was disconnected from the host while + * waiting for the endpoint to become ready. + */ + ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_BusSuspended = 3, /**< The USB bus has been suspended by the host and + * no USB endpoint traffic can occur until the bus + * has resumed. + */ + ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_Timeout = 4, /**< The host failed to accept or send the next packet + * within the software timeout period set by the + * \ref USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS macro. + */ + }; + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Selects the given endpoint address. + * + * Any endpoint operations which do not require the endpoint address to be indicated will operate on + * the currently selected endpoint. + * + * \param[in] Address Endpoint address to select. + */ + void Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(const uint8_t Address); + + /** Configures the specified endpoint address with the given endpoint type, bank size and number of hardware + * banks. Once configured, the endpoint may be read from or written to, depending on its direction. + * + * \param[in] Address Endpoint address to configure. + * + * \param[in] Type Type of endpoint to configure, a \c EP_TYPE_* mask. Not all endpoint types + * are available on Low Speed USB devices - refer to the USB 2.0 specification. + * + * \param[in] Size Size of the endpoint's bank, where packets are stored before they are transmitted + * to the USB host, or after they have been received from the USB host (depending on + * the endpoint's data direction). The bank size must indicate the maximum packet size + * that the endpoint can handle. + * + * \param[in] Banks Number of hardware banks to use for the endpoint being configured. + * + * \note The default control endpoint should not be manually configured by the user application, as + * it is automatically configured by the library internally. + * \n\n + * + * \note This routine will automatically select the specified endpoint. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the configuration succeeded, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(const uint8_t Address, + const uint8_t Type, + const uint16_t Size, + const uint8_t Banks) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(const uint8_t Address, + const uint8_t Type, + const uint16_t Size, + const uint8_t Banks) + { + uint8_t EPConfigMask = (USB_EP_INTDSBL_bm | ((Banks > 1) ? USB_EP_PINGPONG_bm : 0) | Endpoint_BytesToEPSizeMask(Size)); + + if ((Address & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK) >= ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS) + return false; + + // TODO - Fix once limitations are lifted + EPConfigMask &= ~USB_EP_PINGPONG_bm; + if (Size > 64) + return false; + + switch (Type) + { + case EP_TYPE_CONTROL: + EPConfigMask |= USB_EP_TYPE_CONTROL_gc; + break; + case EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS: + EPConfigMask |= USB_EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS_gc; + break; + default: + EPConfigMask |= USB_EP_TYPE_BULK_gc; + break; + } + + if (Type == EP_TYPE_CONTROL) + Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint_PRV(Address ^ ENDPOINT_DIR_IN, EPConfigMask, Size); + + return Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint_PRV(Address, EPConfigMask, Size); + } + + /** Indicates the number of bytes currently stored in the current endpoint's selected bank. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointRW_XMEGA + * + * \return Total number of bytes in the currently selected Endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint16_t Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint16_t Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint(void) + { + if (USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint & ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + return USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Position; + else + return (USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Length - USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Position); + } + + /** Get the endpoint address of the currently selected endpoint. This is typically used to save + * the currently selected endpoint so that it can be restored after another endpoint has been + * manipulated. + * + * \return Index of the currently selected endpoint. + */ + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_GetCurrentEndpoint(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_GetCurrentEndpoint(void) + { + return USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint; + } + + /** Resets the endpoint bank FIFO. This clears all the endpoint banks and resets the USB controller's + * data In and Out pointers to the bank's contents. + * + * \param[in] Address Endpoint address whose FIFO buffers are to be reset. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_ResetEndpoint(const uint8_t Address) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_ResetEndpoint(const uint8_t Address) + { + if (Address & ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + USB_Endpoint_FIFOs[Address & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK].IN.Position = 0; + else + USB_Endpoint_FIFOs[Address & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK].OUT.Position = 0; + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected endpoint is enabled, but not necessarily configured. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the currently selected endpoint is enabled, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_IsEnabled(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_IsEnabled(void) + { + return true; + } + + /** Aborts all pending IN transactions on the currently selected endpoint, once the bank + * has been queued for transmission to the host via \ref Endpoint_ClearIN(). This function + * will terminate all queued transactions, resetting the endpoint banks ready for a new + * packet. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_XMEGA + */ + static inline void Endpoint_AbortPendingIN(void) + { + USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->STATUS |= USB_EP_BUSNACK0_bm; + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected endpoint may be read from (if data is waiting in the endpoint + * bank and the endpoint is an OUT direction, or if the bank is not yet full if the endpoint is an IN + * direction). This function will return false if an error has occurred in the endpoint, if the endpoint + * is an OUT direction and no packet (or an empty packet) has been received, or if the endpoint is an IN + * direction and the endpoint bank is full. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_XMEGA + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the currently selected endpoint may be read from or written to, depending + * on its direction. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed(void) + { + return (USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Position < USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Length); + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected endpoint is configured. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the currently selected endpoint has been configured, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_IsConfigured(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_IsConfigured(void) + { + return ((USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->CTRL & USB_EP_TYPE_gm) ? true : false); + } + + /** Determines if the selected IN endpoint is ready for a new packet to be sent to the host. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_XMEGA + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the current endpoint is ready for an IN packet, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool Endpoint_IsINReady(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + + /** Determines if the selected OUT endpoint has received new packet from the host. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_XMEGA + * + * \return Boolean \c true if current endpoint is has received an OUT packet, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool Endpoint_IsOUTReceived(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + + /** Determines if the current CONTROL type endpoint has received a SETUP packet. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_XMEGA + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the selected endpoint has received a SETUP packet, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + + /** Clears a received SETUP packet on the currently selected CONTROL type endpoint, freeing up the + * endpoint for the next packet. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_XMEGA + * + * \note This is not applicable for non CONTROL type endpoints. + */ + void Endpoint_ClearSETUP(void); + + /** Sends an IN packet to the host on the currently selected endpoint, freeing up the endpoint for the + * next packet and switching to the alternative endpoint bank if double banked. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_XMEGA + */ + void Endpoint_ClearIN(void); + + /** Acknowledges an OUT packet to the host on the currently selected endpoint, freeing up the endpoint + * for the next packet and switching to the alternative endpoint bank if double banked. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_XMEGA + */ + void Endpoint_ClearOUT(void); + + /** Stalls the current endpoint, indicating to the host that a logical problem occurred with the + * indicated endpoint and that the current transfer sequence should be aborted. This provides a + * way for devices to indicate invalid commands to the host so that the current transfer can be + * aborted and the host can begin its own recovery sequence. + * + * The currently selected endpoint remains stalled until either the \ref Endpoint_ClearStall() macro + * is called, or the host issues a CLEAR FEATURE request to the device for the currently selected + * endpoint. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_XMEGA + */ + void Endpoint_StallTransaction(void); + + /** Clears the STALL condition on the currently selected endpoint. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_XMEGA + */ + static inline void Endpoint_ClearStall(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_ClearStall(void) + { + USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->CTRL &= ~USB_EP_STALL_bm; + } + + /** Determines if the currently selected endpoint is stalled, \c false otherwise. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPacketManagement_XMEGA + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the currently selected endpoint is stalled, \c false otherwise. + */ + static inline bool Endpoint_IsStalled(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool Endpoint_IsStalled(void) + { + return ((USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->CTRL & USB_EP_STALL_bm) ? true : false); + } + + /** Resets the data toggle of the currently selected endpoint. */ + static inline void Endpoint_ResetDataToggle(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_ResetDataToggle(void) + { + USB_Endpoint_SelectedHandle->STATUS &= ~USB_EP_TOGGLE_bm; + } + + /** Determines the currently selected endpoint's direction. + * + * \return The currently selected endpoint's direction, as a \c ENDPOINT_DIR_* mask. + */ + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_GetEndpointDirection(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint8_t Endpoint_GetEndpointDirection(void) + { + return (USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint & ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + } + + /** Reads one byte from the currently selected endpoint's bank, for OUT direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_XMEGA + * + * \return Next byte in the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_Read_8(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + + /** Writes one byte to the currently selected endpoint's bank, for IN direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_XMEGA + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write into the the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + void Endpoint_Write_8(const uint8_t Data); + + /** Discards one byte from the currently selected endpoint's bank, for OUT direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_XMEGA + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Discard_8(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Discard_8(void) + { + USB_Endpoint_SelectedFIFO->Position++; + } + + /** Reads two bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank in little endian format, for OUT + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_XMEGA + * + * \return Next two bytes in the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint16_t Endpoint_Read_16_LE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint16_t Endpoint_Read_16_LE(void) + { + uint16_t Byte0 = Endpoint_Read_8(); + uint16_t Byte1 = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + return ((Byte1 << 8) | Byte0); + } + + /** Reads two bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank in big endian format, for OUT + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_XMEGA + * + * \return Next two bytes in the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint16_t Endpoint_Read_16_BE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint16_t Endpoint_Read_16_BE(void) + { + uint16_t Byte0 = Endpoint_Read_8(); + uint16_t Byte1 = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + return ((Byte0 << 8) | Byte1); + } + + /** Writes two bytes to the currently selected endpoint's bank in little endian format, for IN + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_XMEGA + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Write_16_LE(const uint16_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Write_16_LE(const uint16_t Data) + { + Endpoint_Write_8(Data & 0xFF); + Endpoint_Write_8(Data >> 8); + } + + /** Writes two bytes to the currently selected endpoint's bank in big endian format, for IN + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_XMEGA + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Write_16_BE(const uint16_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Write_16_BE(const uint16_t Data) + { + Endpoint_Write_8(Data >> 8); + Endpoint_Write_8(Data & 0xFF); + } + + /** Discards two bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank, for OUT direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_XMEGA + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Discard_16(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Discard_16(void) + { + Endpoint_Discard_8(); + Endpoint_Discard_8(); + } + + /** Reads four bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank in little endian format, for OUT + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_XMEGA + * + * \return Next four bytes in the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint32_t Endpoint_Read_32_LE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint32_t Endpoint_Read_32_LE(void) + { + uint32_t Byte0 = Endpoint_Read_8(); + uint32_t Byte1 = Endpoint_Read_8(); + uint32_t Byte2 = Endpoint_Read_8(); + uint32_t Byte3 = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + return ((Byte3 << 24) | (Byte2 << 16) | (Byte1 << 8) | Byte0); + } + + /** Reads four bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank in big endian format, for OUT + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_XMEGA + * + * \return Next four bytes in the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline uint32_t Endpoint_Read_32_BE(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint32_t Endpoint_Read_32_BE(void) + { + uint32_t Byte0 = Endpoint_Read_8(); + uint32_t Byte1 = Endpoint_Read_8(); + uint32_t Byte2 = Endpoint_Read_8(); + uint32_t Byte3 = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + return ((Byte0 << 24) | (Byte1 << 16) | (Byte2 << 8) | Byte3); + } + + /** Writes four bytes to the currently selected endpoint's bank in little endian format, for IN + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_XMEGA + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Write_32_LE(const uint32_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Write_32_LE(const uint32_t Data) + { + Endpoint_Write_8(Data & 0xFF); + Endpoint_Write_8(Data >> 8); + Endpoint_Write_8(Data >> 16); + Endpoint_Write_8(Data >> 24); + } + + /** Writes four bytes to the currently selected endpoint's bank in big endian format, for IN + * direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_XMEGA + * + * \param[in] Data Data to write to the currently selected endpoint's FIFO buffer. + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Write_32_BE(const uint32_t Data) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Write_32_BE(const uint32_t Data) + { + Endpoint_Write_8(Data >> 24); + Endpoint_Write_8(Data >> 16); + Endpoint_Write_8(Data >> 8); + Endpoint_Write_8(Data & 0xFF); + } + + /** Discards four bytes from the currently selected endpoint's bank, for OUT direction endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointPrimitiveRW_XMEGA + */ + static inline void Endpoint_Discard_32(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void Endpoint_Discard_32(void) + { + Endpoint_Discard_8(); + Endpoint_Discard_8(); + Endpoint_Discard_8(); + Endpoint_Discard_8(); + } + + /* External Variables: */ + /** Global indicating the maximum packet size of the default control endpoint located at address + * 0 in the device. This value is set to the value indicated in the device descriptor in the user + * project once the USB interface is initialized into device mode. + * + * If space is an issue, it is possible to fix this to a static value by defining the control + * endpoint size in the \c FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE token passed to the compiler in the makefile + * via the -D switch. When a fixed control endpoint size is used, the size is no longer dynamically + * read from the descriptors at runtime and instead fixed to the given value. When used, it is + * important that the descriptor control endpoint size value matches the size given as the + * \c FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE token - it is recommended that the \c FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE token + * be used in the device descriptors to ensure this. + * + * \attention This variable should be treated as read-only in the user application, and never manually + * changed in value. + */ + #if (!defined(FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + extern uint8_t USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize; + #else + #define USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE + #endif + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Configures a table of endpoint descriptions, in sequence. This function can be used to configure multiple + * endpoints at the same time. + * + * \note Endpoints with a zero address will be ignored, thus this function cannot be used to configure the + * control endpoint. + * + * \param[in] Table Pointer to a table of endpoint descriptions. + * \param[in] Entries Number of entries in the endpoint table to configure. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if all endpoints configured successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ + bool Endpoint_ConfigureEndpointTable(const USB_Endpoint_Table_t* const Table, + const uint8_t Entries); + + /** Completes the status stage of a control transfer on a CONTROL type endpoint automatically, + * with respect to the data direction. This is a convenience function which can be used to + * simplify user control request handling. + * + * \note This routine should not be called on non CONTROL type endpoints. + */ + void Endpoint_ClearStatusStage(void); + + /** Spin-loops until the currently selected non-control endpoint is ready for the next packet of data + * to be read or written to it. + * + * \note This routine should not be called on CONTROL type endpoints. + * + * \ingroup Group_EndpointRW_XMEGA + * + * \return A value from the \ref Endpoint_WaitUntilReady_ErrorCodes_t enum. + */ + uint8_t Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(void); + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Host_XMEGA.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Host_XMEGA.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b8b8c462cc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Host_XMEGA.c @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/PipeStream_XMEGA.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/PipeStream_XMEGA.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b8b8c462cc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/PipeStream_XMEGA.c @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Pipe_XMEGA.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Pipe_XMEGA.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bb92b1d763 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Pipe_XMEGA.c @@ -0,0 +1,37 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBMode.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c923f31017 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c @@ -0,0 +1,86 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#if defined(TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME) + +uint8_t TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME (void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) +{ + uint8_t* DataStream = ((uint8_t*)Buffer + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length)); + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint & ~ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + if (!(Length)) + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + while (Length) + { + uint8_t USB_DeviceState_LCL = USB_DeviceState; + + if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + else if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Suspended) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_BusSuspended; + else if (Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived()) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_HostAborted; + + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + { + while (Length && Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint()) + { + TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(DataStream); + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(DataStream, 1); + Length--; + } + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + } + + while (!(Endpoint_IsINReady())) + { + uint8_t USB_DeviceState_LCL = USB_DeviceState; + + if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + else if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Suspended) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_BusSuspended; + } + + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_NoError; +} + +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE +#undef TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME +#undef TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b32de813df --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c @@ -0,0 +1,97 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#if defined(TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME) + +uint8_t TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME (const void* const Buffer, + uint16_t Length) +{ + uint8_t* DataStream = ((uint8_t*)Buffer + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length)); + bool LastPacketFull = false; + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(USB_Endpoint_SelectedEndpoint | ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + if (Length > USB_ControlRequest.wLength) + Length = USB_ControlRequest.wLength; + else if (!(Length)) + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + while (Length || LastPacketFull) + { + uint8_t USB_DeviceState_LCL = USB_DeviceState; + + if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + else if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Suspended) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_BusSuspended; + else if (Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived()) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_HostAborted; + else if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + break; + + if (Endpoint_IsINReady()) + { + uint16_t BytesInEndpoint = Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint(); + + while (Length && (BytesInEndpoint < USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize)) + { + TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(DataStream); + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(DataStream, 1); + Length--; + BytesInEndpoint++; + } + + LastPacketFull = (BytesInEndpoint == USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + } + } + + while (!(Endpoint_IsOUTReceived())) + { + uint8_t USB_DeviceState_LCL = USB_DeviceState; + + if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_DeviceDisconnected; + else if (USB_DeviceState_LCL == DEVICE_STATE_Suspended) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_BusSuspended; + else if (Endpoint_IsSETUPReceived()) + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_HostAborted; + } + + return ENDPOINT_RWCSTREAM_NoError; +} + +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE +#undef TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME +#undef TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e55e592eb2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c @@ -0,0 +1,89 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#if defined(TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME) + +uint8_t TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME (TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE const Buffer, + uint16_t Length, + uint16_t* const BytesProcessed) +{ + uint8_t* DataStream = ((uint8_t*)Buffer + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET(Length)); + uint16_t BytesInTransfer = 0; + uint8_t ErrorCode; + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + Length -= *BytesProcessed; + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(DataStream, *BytesProcessed); + } + + while (Length) + { + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT(); + + #if !defined(INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT) + USB_USBTask(); + #endif + + if (BytesProcessed != NULL) + { + *BytesProcessed += BytesInTransfer; + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_IncompleteTransfer; + } + + if ((ErrorCode = Endpoint_WaitUntilReady())) + return ErrorCode; + } + else + { + TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE(DataStream); + TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE(DataStream, 1); + Length--; + BytesInTransfer++; + } + } + + return ENDPOINT_RWSTREAM_NoError; +} + +#undef TEMPLATE_FUNC_NAME +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_TYPE +#undef TEMPLATE_TRANSFER_BYTE +#undef TEMPLATE_CLEAR_ENDPOINT +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_OFFSET +#undef TEMPLATE_BUFFER_MOVE + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/USBController_XMEGA.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/USBController_XMEGA.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4eea57a0bf --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/USBController_XMEGA.c @@ -0,0 +1,204 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_CONTROLLER_C +#include "../USBController.h" + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) +volatile uint8_t USB_CurrentMode = USB_MODE_None; +#endif + +#if !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS) +volatile uint8_t USB_Options; +#endif + +/* Ugly workaround to ensure an aligned table, since __BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT__ == 1 for the 8-bit AVR-GCC toolchain */ +uint8_t USB_EndpointTable[sizeof(USB_EndpointTable_t) + 1]; + +void USB_Init( + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + const uint8_t Mode + #endif + + #if (defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) && !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS)) + , + #elif (!defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) && defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS)) + void + #endif + + #if !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS) + const uint8_t Options + #endif + ) +{ + #if !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS) + USB_Options = Options; + #endif + + uint_reg_t CurrentGlobalInt = GetGlobalInterruptMask(); + GlobalInterruptDisable(); + + NVM.CMD = NVM_CMD_READ_CALIB_ROW_gc; + USB.CAL0 = pgm_read_byte(offsetof(NVM_PROD_SIGNATURES_t, USBCAL0)); + USB.CAL1 = pgm_read_byte(offsetof(NVM_PROD_SIGNATURES_t, USBCAL1)); + NVM.CMD = NVM_CMD_NO_OPERATION_gc; + + /* Ugly workaround to ensure an aligned table, since __BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT__ == 1 for the 8-bit AVR-GCC toolchain */ + USB.EPPTR = ((intptr_t)&USB_EndpointTable[1] & ~(1 << 0)); + USB.CTRLA = (USB_STFRNUM_bm | ((ENDPOINT_TOTAL_ENDPOINTS - 1) << USB_MAXEP_gp)); + + if ((USB_Options & USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) == USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH) + USB.INTCTRLA = (3 << USB_INTLVL_gp); + else if ((USB_Options & USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIMED) == USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIMED) + USB.INTCTRLA = (2 << USB_INTLVL_gp); + else + USB.INTCTRLA = (1 << USB_INTLVL_gp); + + SetGlobalInterruptMask(CurrentGlobalInt); + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) + USB_CurrentMode = Mode; + #endif + + USB_IsInitialized = true; + + USB_ResetInterface(); +} + +void USB_Disable(void) +{ + USB_INT_DisableAllInterrupts(); + USB_INT_ClearAllInterrupts(); + + USB_Detach(); + USB_Controller_Disable(); + + USB_IsInitialized = false; +} + +void USB_ResetInterface(void) +{ + uint8_t PrescalerNeeded; + + #if defined(USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED) + if (USB_Options & USB_DEVICE_OPT_LOWSPEED) + PrescalerNeeded = F_USB / 6000000; + else + PrescalerNeeded = F_USB / 48000000; + #else + PrescalerNeeded = F_USB / 6000000; + #endif + + uint8_t DividerIndex = 0; + while (PrescalerNeeded > 0) + { + DividerIndex++; + PrescalerNeeded >>= 1; + } + + CLK.USBCTRL = (DividerIndex - 1) << CLK_USBPSDIV_gp; + + if (USB_Options & USB_OPT_PLLCLKSRC) + CLK.USBCTRL |= (CLK_USBSRC_PLL_gc | CLK_USBSEN_bm); + else + CLK.USBCTRL |= (CLK_USBSRC_RC32M_gc | CLK_USBSEN_bm); + + USB_Device_SetDeviceAddress(0); + + USB_INT_DisableAllInterrupts(); + USB_INT_ClearAllInterrupts(); + + USB_Controller_Reset(); + USB_Init_Device(); +} + +#if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) +static void USB_Init_Device(void) +{ + USB_DeviceState = DEVICE_STATE_Unattached; + USB_Device_ConfigurationNumber = 0; + + #if !defined(NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP) + USB_Device_RemoteWakeupEnabled = false; + #endif + + #if !defined(NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER) + USB_Device_CurrentlySelfPowered = false; + #endif + + #if !defined(FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE) + USB_Descriptor_Device_t* DeviceDescriptorPtr; + + #if defined(ARCH_HAS_MULTI_ADDRESS_SPACE) && \ + !(defined(USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS) || defined(USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS) || defined(USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS)) + uint8_t DescriptorAddressSpace; + + if (CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor((DTYPE_Device << 8), 0, (void*)&DeviceDescriptorPtr, &DescriptorAddressSpace) != NO_DESCRIPTOR) + { + if (DescriptorAddressSpace == MEMSPACE_FLASH) + USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize = pgm_read_byte(&DeviceDescriptorPtr->Endpoint0Size); + else if (DescriptorAddressSpace == MEMSPACE_EEPROM) + USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize = eeprom_read_byte(&DeviceDescriptorPtr->Endpoint0Size); + else + USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize = DeviceDescriptorPtr->Endpoint0Size; + } + #else + if (CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor((DTYPE_Device << 8), 0, (void*)&DeviceDescriptorPtr) != NO_DESCRIPTOR) + { + #if defined(USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS) + USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize = DeviceDescriptorPtr->Endpoint0Size; + #elif defined(USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS) + USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize = eeprom_read_byte(&DeviceDescriptorPtr->Endpoint0Size); + #else + USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize = pgm_read_byte(&DeviceDescriptorPtr->Endpoint0Size); + #endif + } + #endif + #endif + + if (USB_Options & USB_DEVICE_OPT_LOWSPEED) + USB_Device_SetLowSpeed(); + else + USB_Device_SetFullSpeed(); + + Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP, EP_TYPE_CONTROL, + USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize, 1); + + USB_INT_Enable(USB_INT_BUSEVENTI); + + USB_Attach(); +} +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/USBController_XMEGA.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/USBController_XMEGA.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6bab03a7d3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/USBController_XMEGA.h @@ -0,0 +1,313 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Controller definitions for the AVR XMEGA microcontrollers. + * \copydetails Group_USBManagement_XMEGA + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_USBManagement + * \defgroup Group_USBManagement_XMEGA USB Interface Management (XMEGA) + * \brief USB Controller definitions for the AVR XMEGA microcontrollers. + * + * Functions, macros, variables, enums and types related to the setup and management of the USB interface. + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef __USBCONTROLLER_XMEGA_H__ +#define __USBCONTROLLER_XMEGA_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + #include "../USBMode.h" + #include "../Events.h" + #include "../USBTask.h" + #include "../USBInterrupt.h" + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Macros: */ + #if defined(MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX) + #define ENDPOINT_TABLE_COUNT (MAX_ENDPOINT_INDEX + 1) + #else + #define ENDPOINT_TABLE_COUNT 16 + #endif + + /* Type Defines: */ + typedef struct + { + struct + { + USB_EP_t OUT; + USB_EP_t IN; + } Endpoints[ENDPOINT_TABLE_COUNT]; + uint16_t FrameNum; + } ATTR_PACKED USB_EndpointTable_t; + + /* External Variables: */ + extern uint8_t USB_EndpointTable[]; + #endif + + /* Includes: */ + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #include "../Device.h" + #include "../Endpoint.h" + #include "../DeviceStandardReq.h" + #include "../EndpointStream.h" + #endif + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks and Defines: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + #if !defined(F_USB) + #error F_USB is not defined. You must define F_USB to the frequency of the unprescaled USB controller clock in your project makefile. + #endif + + #if ((F_USB % 6000000) || (F_USB < 6000000)) + #error Invalid F_USB specified. F_USB must be a multiple of 6MHz for USB Low Speed operation, and a multiple of 48MHz for Full Speed operation. + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** \name USB Controller Option Masks */ + //@{ + /** Sets the USB bus interrupt priority level to be low priority. The USB bus interrupt is used for Start of Frame events, bus suspend + * and resume events, bus reset events and other events related to the management of the USB bus. + */ + #define USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRILOW ((0 << 2) | (0 << 1)) + + /** Sets the USB bus interrupt priority level to be medium priority. The USB bus interrupt is used for Start of Frame events, bus suspend + * and resume events, bus reset events and other events related to the management of the USB bus. + */ + #define USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIMED ((0 << 2) | (1 << 1)) + + /** Sets the USB bus interrupt priority level to be high priority. The USB bus interrupt is used for Start of Frame events, bus suspend + * and resume events, bus reset events and other events related to the management of the USB bus. + */ + #define USB_OPT_BUSEVENT_PRIHIGH ((1 << 2) | (0 << 1)) + + /** Sets the USB controller to source its clock from the internal RC 32MHz clock, once it has been DFLL calibrated to 48MHz. */ + #define USB_OPT_RC32MCLKSRC (0 << 3) + + /** Sets the USB controller to source its clock from the internal PLL. */ + #define USB_OPT_PLLCLKSRC (1 << 3) + //@} + + #if !defined(USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Constant for the maximum software timeout period of the USB data stream transfer functions + * (both control and standard) when in either device or host mode. If the next packet of a stream + * is not received or acknowledged within this time period, the stream function will fail. + * + * This value may be overridden in the user project makefile as the value of the + * \ref USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS token, and passed to the compiler using the -D switch. + */ + #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS 100 + #endif + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Detaches the device from the USB bus. This has the effect of removing the device from any + * attached host, ceasing USB communications. If no host is present, this prevents any host from + * enumerating the device once attached until \ref USB_Attach() is called. + */ + static inline void USB_Detach(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Detach(void) + { + USB.CTRLB &= ~USB_ATTACH_bm; + } + + /** Attaches the device to the USB bus. This announces the device's presence to any attached + * USB host, starting the enumeration process. If no host is present, attaching the device + * will allow for enumeration once a host is connected to the device. + * + * This is inexplicably also required for proper operation while in host mode, to enable the + * attachment of a device to the host. This is despite the bit being located in the device-mode + * register and despite the datasheet making no mention of its requirement in host mode. + */ + static inline void USB_Attach(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Attach(void) + { + USB.CTRLB |= USB_ATTACH_bm; + } + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Main function to initialize and start the USB interface. Once active, the USB interface will + * allow for device connection to a host when in device mode, or for device enumeration while in + * host mode. + * + * As the USB library relies on interrupts for the device and host mode enumeration processes, + * the user must enable global interrupts before or shortly after this function is called. In + * device mode, interrupts must be enabled within 500ms of this function being called to ensure + * that the host does not time out whilst enumerating the device. In host mode, interrupts may be + * enabled at the application's leisure however enumeration will not begin of an attached device + * until after this has occurred. + * + * Calling this function when the USB interface is already initialized will cause a complete USB + * interface reset and re-enumeration. + * + * \param[in] Mode Mask indicating what mode the USB interface is to be initialized to, a value + * from the \ref USB_Modes_t enum. + * \note This parameter does not exist on devices with only one supported USB + * mode (device or host). + * + * \param[in] Options Mask indicating the options which should be used when initializing the USB + * interface to control the USB interface's behavior. This should be comprised of + * a \c USB_OPT_REG_* mask to control the regulator, a \c USB_OPT_*_PLL mask to control the + * PLL, and a \c USB_DEVICE_OPT_* mask (when the device mode is enabled) to set the device + * mode speed. + * + * \note To reduce the FLASH requirements of the library if only device or host mode is required, + * the mode can be statically set in the project makefile by defining the token \c USB_DEVICE_ONLY + * (for device mode) or \c USB_HOST_ONLY (for host mode), passing the token to the compiler + * via the -D switch. If the mode is statically set, this parameter does not exist in the + * function prototype. + * \n\n + * + * \note To reduce the FLASH requirements of the library if only fixed settings are required, + * the options may be set statically in the same manner as the mode (see the Mode parameter of + * this function). To statically set the USB options, pass in the \c USE_STATIC_OPTIONS token, + * defined to the appropriate options masks. When the options are statically set, this + * parameter does not exist in the function prototype. + * \n\n + * + * \note The mode parameter does not exist on devices where only one mode is possible, such as USB + * AVR models which only implement the USB device mode in hardware. + * + * \see \ref Group_Device for the \c USB_DEVICE_OPT_* masks. + */ + void USB_Init( + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + const uint8_t Mode + #endif + + #if (defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) && !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS)) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + , + #elif (!defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) && defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS)) + void + #endif + + #if !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + const uint8_t Options + #endif + ); + + /** Shuts down the USB interface. This turns off the USB interface after deallocating all USB FIFO + * memory, endpoints and pipes. When turned off, no USB functionality can be used until the interface + * is restarted with the \ref USB_Init() function. + */ + void USB_Disable(void); + + /** Resets the interface, when already initialized. This will re-enumerate the device if already connected + * to a host, or re-enumerate an already attached device when in host mode. + */ + void USB_ResetInterface(void); + + /* Global Variables: */ + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Indicates the mode that the USB interface is currently initialized to, a value from the + * \ref USB_Modes_t enum. + * + * \attention This variable should be treated as read-only in the user application, and never manually + * changed in value. + * + * \note When the controller is initialized into UID auto-detection mode, this variable will hold the + * currently selected USB mode (i.e. \ref USB_MODE_Device or \ref USB_MODE_Host). If the controller + * is fixed into a specific mode (either through the \c USB_DEVICE_ONLY or \c USB_HOST_ONLY compile time + * options, or a limitation of the USB controller in the chosen device model) this will evaluate to + * a constant of the appropriate value and will never evaluate to \ref USB_MODE_None even when the + * USB interface is not initialized. + */ + extern volatile uint8_t USB_CurrentMode; + #elif defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) + #define USB_CurrentMode USB_MODE_Host + #elif defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) + #define USB_CurrentMode USB_MODE_Device + #endif + + #if !defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Indicates the current USB options that the USB interface was initialized with when \ref USB_Init() + * was called. This value will be one of the \c USB_MODE_* masks defined elsewhere in this module. + * + * \attention This variable should be treated as read-only in the user application, and never manually + * changed in value. + */ + extern volatile uint8_t USB_Options; + #elif defined(USE_STATIC_OPTIONS) + #define USB_Options USE_STATIC_OPTIONS + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Function Prototypes: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_CONTROLLER_C) + static void USB_Init_Device(void); + #endif + + /* Inline Functions: */ + static inline void USB_Controller_Enable(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Controller_Enable(void) + { + USB.CTRLA |= USB_ENABLE_bm; + } + + static inline void USB_Controller_Disable(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Controller_Disable(void) + { + USB.CTRLA &= ~USB_ENABLE_bm; + } + + static inline void USB_Controller_Reset(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_Controller_Reset(void) + { + USB.CTRLA &= ~USB_ENABLE_bm; + USB.CTRLA |= USB_ENABLE_bm; + } + + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/USBInterrupt_XMEGA.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/USBInterrupt_XMEGA.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a82dde030c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/USBInterrupt_XMEGA.c @@ -0,0 +1,106 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER +#include "../USBInterrupt.h" + +void USB_INT_DisableAllInterrupts(void) +{ + USB.INTCTRLA &= USB_INTLVL_gm; + USB.INTCTRLB = 0; +} + +void USB_INT_ClearAllInterrupts(void) +{ + USB.INTFLAGSACLR = 0xFF; + USB.INTFLAGSBCLR = 0xFF; +} + +ISR(USB_BUSEVENT_vect) +{ + #if !defined(NO_SOF_EVENTS) + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_SOFI) && USB_INT_IsEnabled(USB_INT_SOFI)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_SOFI); + + EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(); + } + #endif + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_BUSEVENTI_Suspend)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_BUSEVENTI_Suspend); + + #if !defined(NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT) + USB_DeviceState = DEVICE_STATE_Unattached; + EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(); + #else + USB_DeviceState = DEVICE_STATE_Suspended; + EVENT_USB_Device_Suspend(); + #endif + } + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_BUSEVENTI_Resume)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_BUSEVENTI_Resume); + + if (USB_Device_ConfigurationNumber) + USB_DeviceState = DEVICE_STATE_Configured; + else + USB_DeviceState = (USB_Device_IsAddressSet()) ? DEVICE_STATE_Addressed : DEVICE_STATE_Powered; + + #if !defined(NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT) + EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(); + #else + EVENT_USB_Device_WakeUp(); + #endif + } + + if (USB_INT_HasOccurred(USB_INT_BUSEVENTI_Reset)) + { + USB_INT_Clear(USB_INT_BUSEVENTI_Reset); + + USB_DeviceState = DEVICE_STATE_Default; + USB_Device_ConfigurationNumber = 0; + + USB_Device_EnableDeviceAddress(0); + + Endpoint_ClearEndpoints(); + Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(ENDPOINT_CONTROLEP, EP_TYPE_CONTROL, + USB_Device_ControlEndpointSize, 1); + + EVENT_USB_Device_Reset(); + } +} + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/USBInterrupt_XMEGA.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/USBInterrupt_XMEGA.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..54ee7f115f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/USBInterrupt_XMEGA.h @@ -0,0 +1,172 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief USB Controller Interrupt definitions for the AVR XMEGA microcontrollers. + * + * This file contains definitions required for the correct handling of low level USB service routine interrupts + * from the USB controller. + * + * \note This file should not be included directly. It is automatically included as needed by the USB driver + * dispatch header located in LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h. + */ + +#ifndef __USBINTERRUPT_XMEGA_H__ +#define __USBINTERRUPT_XMEGA_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if !defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER) + #error Do not include this file directly. Include LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h instead. + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Enums: */ + enum USB_Interrupts_t + { + USB_INT_BUSEVENTI = 1, + USB_INT_BUSEVENTI_Suspend = 2, + USB_INT_BUSEVENTI_Resume = 3, + USB_INT_BUSEVENTI_Reset = 4, + USB_INT_SOFI = 5, + }; + + /* Inline Functions: */ + static inline void USB_INT_Enable(const uint8_t Interrupt) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_INT_Enable(const uint8_t Interrupt) + { + switch (Interrupt) + { + case USB_INT_BUSEVENTI: + USB.INTCTRLA |= USB_BUSEVIE_bm; + break; + case USB_INT_SOFI: + USB.INTCTRLA |= USB_SOFIE_bm; + break; + default: + break; + } + } + + static inline void USB_INT_Disable(const uint8_t Interrupt) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_INT_Disable(const uint8_t Interrupt) + { + switch (Interrupt) + { + case USB_INT_BUSEVENTI: + USB.INTCTRLA &= ~USB_BUSEVIE_bm; + break; + case USB_INT_SOFI: + USB.INTCTRLA &= ~USB_SOFIE_bm; + break; + default: + break; + } + } + + static inline void USB_INT_Clear(const uint8_t Interrupt) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void USB_INT_Clear(const uint8_t Interrupt) + { + switch (Interrupt) + { + case USB_INT_BUSEVENTI_Suspend: + USB.INTFLAGSACLR = USB_SUSPENDIF_bm; + break; + case USB_INT_BUSEVENTI_Resume: + USB.INTFLAGSACLR = USB_RESUMEIF_bm; + break; + case USB_INT_BUSEVENTI_Reset: + USB.INTFLAGSACLR = USB_RSTIF_bm; + break; + case USB_INT_SOFI: + USB.INTFLAGSACLR = USB_SOFIF_bm; + break; + default: + break; + } + } + + static inline bool USB_INT_IsEnabled(const uint8_t Interrupt) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline bool USB_INT_IsEnabled(const uint8_t Interrupt) + { + switch (Interrupt) + { + case USB_INT_BUSEVENTI: + return ((USB.INTCTRLA & USB_BUSEVIE_bm) ? true : false); + case USB_INT_SOFI: + return ((USB.INTCTRLA & USB_SOFIE_bm) ? true : false); + default: + return false; + } + } + + static inline bool USB_INT_HasOccurred(const uint8_t Interrupt) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline bool USB_INT_HasOccurred(const uint8_t Interrupt) + { + switch (Interrupt) + { + case USB_INT_BUSEVENTI_Suspend: + return ((USB.INTFLAGSACLR & USB_SUSPENDIF_bm) ? true : false); + case USB_INT_BUSEVENTI_Resume: + return ((USB.INTFLAGSACLR & USB_RESUMEIF_bm) ? true : false); + case USB_INT_BUSEVENTI_Reset: + return ((USB.INTFLAGSACLR & USB_RSTIF_bm) ? true : false); + case USB_INT_SOFI: + return ((USB.INTFLAGSACLR & USB_SOFIF_bm) ? true : false); + default: + return false; + } + } + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../USBMode.h" + #include "../Events.h" + #include "../USBController.h" + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void USB_INT_ClearAllInterrupts(void); + void USB_INT_DisableAllInterrupts(void); + #endif + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..87c098cb9d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h @@ -0,0 +1,422 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Master include file for the library USB functionality. + * + * Master include file for the library USB functionality. + * + * This file should be included in all user projects making use of the USB portions of the library, instead of + * the individual USB driver submodule headers. + */ + +/** \defgroup Group_USB USB Core - LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h + * + * \brief Core driver for the microcontroller hardware USB module + * + * \section Sec_USB_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/ConfigDescriptors.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USB)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/DeviceStandardReq.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USB)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/Events.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USB)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/HostStandardReq.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USB)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/USBTask.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USB)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/<i>ARCH</i>/Device_<i>ARCH</i>.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USB)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/<i>ARCH</i>/Endpoint_<i>ARCH</i>.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USB)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/<i>ARCH</i>/EndpointStream_<i>ARCH</i>.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USB)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/<i>ARCH</i>/Host_<i>ARCH</i>.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USB)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/<i>ARCH</i>/Pipe_<i>ARCH</i>.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USB)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/<i>ARCH</i>/PipeStream_<i>ARCH</i>.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USB)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/<i>ARCH</i>/USBController_<i>ARCH</i>.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USB)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Core/<i>ARCH</i>/USBInterrupt_<i>ARCH</i>.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USB)</i> + * - LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDParser.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_USB)</i> + * + * \section Sec_USB_ModDescription Module Description + * Driver and framework for the USB controller of the selected architecture and microcontroller model. This module + * consists of many submodules, and is designed to provide an easy way to configure and control USB host, device + * or OTG mode USB applications. + * + * The USB stack requires the sole control over the USB controller in the microcontroller only; i.e. it does not + * require any additional timers or other peripherals to operate. This ensures that the USB stack requires as few + * resources as possible. + * + * The USB stack can be used in Device Mode for connections to USB Hosts (see \ref Group_Device), in Host mode for + * hosting of other USB devices (see \ref Group_Host), or as a dual role device which can either act as a USB host + * or device depending on what peripheral is connected (see \ref Group_OTG). Both modes also require a common set + * of USB management functions found \ref Group_USBManagement. + */ + +/** \defgroup Group_USBClassDrivers USB Class Drivers + * + * \brief Drivers for the various standardized USB device classes + * + * Drivers for both host and device mode of the standard USB classes, for rapid application development. + * Class drivers give a framework which sits on top of the low level library API, allowing for standard + * USB classes to be implemented in a project with minimal user code. These drivers can be used in + * conjunction with the library low level APIs to implement interfaces both via the class drivers and via + * the standard library APIs. + * + * Multiple device mode class drivers can be used within a project, including multiple instances of the + * same class driver. In this way, USB Hosts and Devices can be made quickly using the internal class drivers + * so that more time and effort can be put into the end application instead of the USB protocol. + * + * The available class drivers and their modes are listed below. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th width="200px">USB Class</th> + * <th width="90px">Device Mode</th> + * <th width="90px">Host Mode</th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Android Open Accessory</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Audio 1.0</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>CDC-ACM</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>HID</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MIDI</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Mass Storage</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Printer</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>RNDIS</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Still Image</td> + * <td bgcolor="#EE0000">No</td> + * <td bgcolor="#00EE00">Yes</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * + * \section Sec_USB_UsingClassDrivers Using the Class Drivers + * To make the Class drivers easy to integrate into a user application, they all implement a standardized + * design with similarly named/used function, enums, defines and types. The two different modes are implemented + * slightly differently, and thus will be explained separately. For information on a specific class driver, read + * the class driver's module documentation. + * + * \subsection Sec_USB_ClassDriverDevice Device Mode Class Drivers + * Implementing a Device Mode Class Driver in a user application requires a number of steps to be followed. Firstly, + * the module configuration and state structure must be added to the project source. These structures are named in a + * similar manner between classes, that of <tt>USB_ClassInfo_<i>{Class Name}</i>_Device_t</tt>, and are used to hold the + * complete state and configuration for each class instance. Multiple class instances is where the power of the class + * drivers lie; multiple interfaces of the same class simply require more instances of the Class Driver's \c USB_ClassInfo_* + * structure. + * + * Inside the ClassInfo structure lies two sections, a \c Config section, and a \c State section. The \c Config + * section contains the instance's configuration parameters, and <b>must have all fields set by the user application</b> + * before the class driver is used. Each Device mode Class driver typically contains a set of configuration parameters + * for the endpoint size/number of the associated logical USB interface, plus any class-specific configuration parameters. + * + * The following is an example of a properly initialized instance of the Audio Class Driver structure: + * + * \code + * USB_ClassInfo_Audio_Device_t My_Audio_Interface = + * { + * .Config = + * { + * .StreamingInterfaceNumber = 1, + * .DataINEndpoint = + * { + * .Address = (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1), + * .Size = 64, + * .Banks = 1, + * }, + * }, + * }; + * \endcode + * + * \note The class driver's configuration parameters should match those used in the device's descriptors that are + * sent to the host. + * + * To initialize the Class driver instance, the driver's <tt><i>{Class Name}</i>_Device_ConfigureEndpoints()</tt> function + * should be called in response to the \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged() event. This function will return a + * boolean true value if the driver successfully initialized the instance. Like all the class driver functions, this function + * takes in the address of the specific instance you wish to initialize - in this manner, multiple separate instances of + * the same class type can be initialized like this: + * + * \code + * void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) + * { + * LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + * + * if (!(Audio_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&My_Audio_Interface))) + * LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + * } + * \endcode + * + * Once initialized, it is important to maintain the class driver's state by repeatedly calling the Class Driver's + * <tt><i>{Class Name}</i>_Device_USBTask()</tt> function in the main program loop. The exact implementation of this + * function varies between class drivers, and can be used for any internal class driver purpose to maintain each + * instance. Again, this function uses the address of the instance to operate on, and thus needs to be called for each + * separate instance, just like the main USB maintenance routine \ref USB_USBTask(): + * + * \code + * int main(void) + * { + * SetupHardware(); + * + * LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + * + * for (;;) + * { + * if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + * Create_And_Process_Samples(); + * + * Audio_Device_USBTask(&My_Audio_Interface); + * USB_USBTask(); + * } + * } + * \endcode + * + * The final standardized Device Class Driver function is the Control Request handler function + * <tt><i>{Class Name}</i>_Device_ProcessControlRequest()</tt>, which should be called when the + * \ref EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest() event fires. This function should also be called for + * each class driver instance, using the address of the instance to operate on as the function's + * parameter. The request handler will abort if it is determined that the current request is not + * targeted at the given class driver instance, thus these methods can safely be called + * one-after-another in the event handler with no form of error checking: + * + * \code + * void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) + * { + * Audio_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&My_Audio_Interface); + * } + * \endcode + * + * Each class driver may also define a set of callback functions (which are prefixed by \c CALLBACK_* + * in the function's name) which <b>must</b> also be added to the user application - refer to each + * individual class driver's documentation for mandatory callbacks. In addition, each class driver may + * also define a set of events (identifiable by their prefix of \c EVENT_* in the function's name), which + * the user application <b>may</b> choose to implement, or ignore if not needed. + * + * The individual Device Mode Class Driver documentation contains more information on the non-standardized, + * class-specific functions which the user application can then use on the driver instances, such as data + * read and write routines. See each driver's individual documentation for more information on the + * class-specific functions. + * + * \subsection Sec_USB_ClassDriverHost Host Mode Class Drivers + * Implementing a Host Mode Class Driver in a user application requires a number of steps to be followed. Firstly, + * the module configuration and state structure must be added to the project source. These structures are named in a + * similar manner between classes, that of <tt>USB_ClassInfo_<b>{Class Name}</b>_Host_t</tt>, and are used to hold the + * complete state and configuration for each class instance. Multiple class instances is where the power of the class + * drivers lie; multiple interfaces of the same class simply require more instances of the Class Driver's \c USB_ClassInfo_* + * structure. + * + * Inside the \c USB_ClassInfo_* structure lies two sections, a \c Config section, and a \c State section. The \c Config + * section contains the instance's configuration parameters, and <b>must have all fields set by the user application</b> + * before the class driver is used. Each Device mode Class driver typically contains a set of configuration parameters + * for the endpoint size/number of the associated logical USB interface, plus any class-specific configuration parameters. + * + * The following is an example of a properly initialized instance of the MIDI Host Class Driver structure: + * + * \code + * USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Host_t My_MIDI_Interface = + * { + * .Config = + * { + * .DataINPipe = + * { + * .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1), + * .Size = 64, + * .Banks = 1, + * }, + * .DataOUTPipe = + * { + * .Address = (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2), + * .Size = 64, + * .Banks = 1, + * }, + * }, + * }; + * \endcode + * + * To initialize the Class driver instance, the driver's <tt><b>{Class Name}</b>_Host_ConfigurePipes()</tt> function + * should be called in response to the \c EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete() event firing. This function will + * will return an error code from the class driver's <tt><b>{Class Name}</b>_EnumerationFailure_ErrorCodes_t</tt> enum + * to indicate if the driver successfully initialized the instance and bound it to an interface in the attached device. + * Like all the class driver functions, this function takes in the address of the specific instance you wish to initialize - + * in this manner, multiple separate instances of the same class type can be initialized. A fragment of a Class Driver + * based Host mode application may look like the following: + * + * \code + * void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) + * { + * LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + * + * uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize; + * uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + * + * if (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData, + * sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData)) != HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful) + * { + * LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + * return; + * } + * + * if (MIDI_Host_ConfigurePipes(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface, + * ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData) != MIDI_ENUMERROR_NoError) + * { + * LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + * return; + * } + * + * if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + * { + * LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + * return; + * } + * + * LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + * } + * \endcode + * + * Note that the function also requires the device's configuration descriptor so that it can determine which interface + * in the device to bind to - this can be retrieved as shown in the above fragment using the + * \ref USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor() function. If the device does not implement the interface the class driver + * is looking for, if all the matching interfaces are already bound to class driver instances or if an error occurs while + * binding to a device interface (for example, a device endpoint bank larger that the maximum supported bank size is used) + * the configuration will fail. + * + * To complete the device enumeration after binding the host mode Class Drivers to the attached device, a call to + * \c USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration() must be made. If the device configuration is not set within the + * \c EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete() event, the host still will assume the device enumeration has failed. + * + * Once initialized, it is important to maintain the class driver's state by repeatedly calling the Class Driver's + * <tt><b>{Class Name}</b>_Host_USBTask()</tt> function in the main program loop. The exact implementation of this + * function varies between class drivers, and can be used for any internal class driver purpose to maintain each + * instance. Again, this function uses the address of the instance to operate on, and thus needs to be called for each + * separate instance, just like the main USB maintenance routine \ref USB_USBTask(): + * + * \code + * int main(void) + * { + * SetupHardware(); + * + * LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + * + * for (;;) + * { + * if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + * Create_And_Process_Samples(); + * + * MIDI_Host_USBTask(&My_Audio_Interface); + * USB_USBTask(); + * } + * } + * \endcode + * + * Each class driver may also define a set of callback functions (which are prefixed by \c CALLBACK_* + * in the function's name) which <b>must</b> also be added to the user application - refer to each + * individual class driver's documentation for mandatory callbacks. In addition, each class driver may + * also define a set of events (identifiable by their prefix of \c EVENT_* in the function's name), which + * the user application <b>may</b> choose to implement, or ignore if not needed. + * + * The individual Host Mode Class Driver documentation contains more information on the non-standardized, + * class-specific functions which the user application can then use on the driver instances, such as data + * read and write routines. See each driver's individual documentation for more information on the + * class-specific functions. + */ + +#ifndef __USB_H__ +#define __USB_H__ + + /* Macros: */ + #define __INCLUDE_FROM_USB_DRIVER + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Common/Common.h" + #include "Core/USBMode.h" + + /* Includes: */ + #include "Core/USBTask.h" + #include "Core/Events.h" + #include "Core/StdDescriptors.h" + #include "Core/ConfigDescriptors.h" + #include "Core/USBController.h" + #include "Core/USBInterrupt.h" + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_HOST) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #include "Core/Host.h" + #include "Core/Pipe.h" + #include "Core/HostStandardReq.h" + #include "Core/PipeStream.h" + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_DEVICE) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #include "Core/Device.h" + #include "Core/Endpoint.h" + #include "Core/DeviceStandardReq.h" + #include "Core/EndpointStream.h" + #endif + + #if defined(USB_CAN_BE_BOTH) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + #include "Core/OTG.h" + #endif + + #include "Class/AndroidAccessoryClass.h" + #include "Class/AudioClass.h" + #include "Class/CDCClass.h" + #include "Class/HIDClass.h" + #include "Class/MassStorageClass.h" + #include "Class/MIDIClass.h" + #include "Class/PrinterClass.h" + #include "Class/RNDISClass.h" + #include "Class/StillImageClass.h" + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/License.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/License.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f89d606d2e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/License.txt @@ -0,0 +1,24 @@ + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org + + +Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software +and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted without +fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all +copies and that both that the copyright notice and this +permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting +documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in +advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the +software without specific, written prior permission. + +The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this +software, including all implied warranties of merchantability +and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any +special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages +whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether +in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, +arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of +this software. diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/Platform.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/Platform.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9997d797f7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/Platform.h @@ -0,0 +1,80 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Architecture Specific Hardware Platform Drivers. + * + * This file is the master dispatch header file for the device-specific hardware platform drivers, for low level + * hardware configuration and management. The platform drivers are a set of drivers which are designed to provide + * a high level management layer for the various low level system functions such as clock control and interrupt + * management. + * + * User code may choose to either include this master dispatch header file to include all available platform + * driver header files for the current architecture, or may choose to only include the specific platform driver + * modules required for a particular application. + */ + +/** \defgroup Group_PlatformDrivers System Platform Drivers - LUFA/Platform/Platform.h + * \brief Hardware platform drivers. + * + * \section Sec_PlatformDrivers_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - <b>UC3 Architecture Only:</b> LUFA/Platform/UC3/InterruptManagement.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_PLATFORM)</i> + * - <b>UC3 Architecture Only:</b> LUFA/Platform/UC3/Exception.S <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_PLATFORM)</i> + * + * \section Sec_PlatformDrivers_ModDescription Module Description + * Device-specific hardware platform drivers, for low level hardware configuration and management. The platform + * drivers are a set of drivers which are designed to provide a high level management layer for the various low level + * system functions such as clock control and interrupt management. + * + * User code may choose to either include this master dispatch header file to include all available platform + * driver header files for the current architecture, or may choose to only include the specific platform driver + * modules required for a particular application. + * + * \note The exact APIs and availability of sub-modules within the platform driver group may vary depending on the + * target used - see individual target module documentation for the API specific to your target processor. + */ + +#ifndef __LUFA_PLATFORM_H__ +#define __LUFA_PLATFORM_H__ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../Common/Common.h" + + /* Includes: */ + #if (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + #include "UC3/ClockManagement.h" + #include "UC3/InterruptManagement.h" + #elif (ARCH == ARCH_XMEGA) + #include "XMEGA/ClockManagement.h" + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/UC3/ClockManagement.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/UC3/ClockManagement.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5f286d51d5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/UC3/ClockManagement.h @@ -0,0 +1,338 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Module Clock Driver for the AVR32 UC3 microcontrollers. + * + * Clock management driver for the AVR32 UC3 microcontrollers. This driver allows for the configuration + * of the various clocks within the device to clock the various peripherals. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PlatformDrivers_UC3 + * \defgroup Group_PlatformDrivers_UC3Clocks Clock Management Driver - LUFA/Platform/UC3/ClockManagement.h + * \brief Module Clock Driver for the AVR32 UC3 microcontrollers. + * + * \section Sec_PlatformDrivers_UC3Clocks_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - None + * + * \section Sec_PlatformDrivers_UC3Clocks_ModDescription Module Description + * Clock management driver for the AVR32 UC3 microcontrollers. This driver allows for the configuration + * of the various clocks within the device to clock the various peripherals. + * + * Usage Example: + * \code + * #include <LUFA/Platform/UC3/ClockManagement.h> + * + * void main(void) + * { + * // Start the master external oscillator which will be used as the main clock reference + * UC3CLK_StartExternalOscillator(0, EXOSC_MODE_8MHZ_OR_MORE, EXOSC_START_0CLK); + * + * // Start the PLL for the CPU clock, switch CPU to it + * UC3CLK_StartPLL(0, CLOCK_SRC_OSC0, 12000000, F_CPU); + * UC3CLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL0, F_CPU); + * + * // Start the PLL for the USB Generic Clock module + * UC3CLK_StartPLL(1, CLOCK_SRC_OSC0, 12000000, 48000000); + * } + * \endcode + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _UC3_CLOCK_MANAGEMENT_H_ +#define _UC3_CLOCK_MANAGEMENT_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Enum for the possible external oscillator types. */ + enum UC3_Extern_OSC_ClockTypes_t + { + EXOSC_MODE_CLOCK = AVR32_PM_OSCCTRL0_MODE_EXT_CLOCK, /**< External clock (non-crystal) mode. */ + EXOSC_MODE_900KHZ_MAX = AVR32_PM_OSCCTRL0_MODE_CRYSTAL_G0, /**< External crystal oscillator equal to or slower than 900KHz. */ + EXOSC_MODE_3MHZ_MAX = AVR32_PM_OSCCTRL0_MODE_CRYSTAL_G1, /**< External crystal oscillator equal to or slower than 3MHz. */ + EXOSC_MODE_8MHZ_MAX = AVR32_PM_OSCCTRL0_MODE_CRYSTAL_G2, /**< External crystal oscillator equal to or slower than 8MHz. */ + EXOSC_MODE_8MHZ_OR_MORE = AVR32_PM_OSCCTRL0_MODE_CRYSTAL_G3, /**< External crystal oscillator equal to or faster than 8MHz. */ + }; + + /** Enum for the possible external oscillator startup times. */ + enum UC3_Extern_OSC_ClockStartup_t + { + EXOSC_START_0CLK = AVR32_PM_OSCCTRL0_STARTUP_0_RCOSC, /**< Immediate startup, no delay. */ + EXOSC_START_64CLK = AVR32_PM_OSCCTRL0_STARTUP_64_RCOSC, /**< Wait 64 clock cycles before startup for stability. */ + EXOSC_START_128CLK = AVR32_PM_OSCCTRL0_STARTUP_128_RCOSC, /**< Wait 128 clock cycles before startup for stability. */ + EXOSC_START_2048CLK = AVR32_PM_OSCCTRL0_STARTUP_2048_RCOSC, /**< Wait 2048 clock cycles before startup for stability. */ + EXOSC_START_4096CLK = AVR32_PM_OSCCTRL0_STARTUP_4096_RCOSC, /**< Wait 4096 clock cycles before startup for stability. */ + EXOSC_START_8192CLK = AVR32_PM_OSCCTRL0_STARTUP_8192_RCOSC, /**< Wait 8192 clock cycles before startup for stability. */ + EXOSC_START_16384CLK = AVR32_PM_OSCCTRL0_STARTUP_16384_RCOSC, /**< Wait 16384 clock cycles before startup for stability. */ + }; + + /** Enum for the possible module clock sources. */ + enum UC3_System_ClockSource_t + { + CLOCK_SRC_SLOW_CLK = 0, /**< Clock sourced from the internal slow clock. */ + CLOCK_SRC_OSC0 = 1, /**< Clock sourced from the Oscillator 0 clock. */ + CLOCK_SRC_OSC1 = 2, /**< Clock sourced from the Oscillator 1 clock. */ + CLOCK_SRC_PLL0 = 3, /**< Clock sourced from the PLL 0 clock. */ + CLOCK_SRC_PLL1 = 4, /**< Clock sourced from the PLL 1 clock. */ + }; + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Starts the given external oscillator of the UC3 microcontroller, with the given options. This routine blocks until + * the oscillator is ready for use. + * + * \param[in] Channel Index of the external oscillator to start. + * \param[in] Type Type of clock attached to the given oscillator channel, a value from \ref UC3_Extern_OSC_ClockTypes_t. + * \param[in] Startup Startup time of the external oscillator, a value from \ref UC3_Extern_OSC_ClockStartup_t. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the external oscillator was successfully started, \c false if invalid parameters specified. + */ + static inline bool UC3CLK_StartExternalOscillator(const uint8_t Channel, + const uint8_t Type, + const uint8_t Startup) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool UC3CLK_StartExternalOscillator(const uint8_t Channel, + const uint8_t Type, + const uint8_t Startup) + { + switch (Channel) + { + case 0: + AVR32_PM.OSCCTRL0.startup = Startup; + AVR32_PM.OSCCTRL0.mode = Type; + break; + case 1: + AVR32_PM.OSCCTRL1.startup = Startup; + AVR32_PM.OSCCTRL1.mode = Type; + break; + default: + return false; + } + + AVR32_PM.mcctrl |= (1 << (AVR32_PM_MCCTRL_OSC0EN_OFFSET + Channel)); + + while (!(AVR32_PM.poscsr & (1 << (AVR32_PM_POSCSR_OSC0RDY_OFFSET + Channel)))); + return true; + } + + /** Stops the given external oscillator of the UC3 microcontroller. + * + * \param[in] Channel Index of the external oscillator to stop. + */ + static inline void UC3CLK_StopExternalOscillator(const uint8_t Channel) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void UC3CLK_StopExternalOscillator(const uint8_t Channel) + { + AVR32_PM.mcctrl &= ~(1 << (AVR32_PM_MCCTRL_OSC0EN_OFFSET + Channel)); + } + + /** Starts the given PLL of the UC3 microcontroller, with the given options. This routine blocks until the PLL is ready for use. + * + * \attention The output frequency must be equal to or greater than the source frequency. + * + * \param[in] Channel Index of the PLL to start. + * \param[in] Source Clock source for the PLL, a value from \ref UC3_System_ClockSource_t. + * \param[in] SourceFreq Frequency of the PLL's clock source, in Hz. + * \param[in] Frequency Target frequency of the PLL's output. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the PLL was successfully started, \c false if invalid parameters specified. + */ + static inline bool UC3CLK_StartPLL(const uint8_t Channel, + const uint8_t Source, + const uint32_t SourceFreq, + const uint32_t Frequency) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool UC3CLK_StartPLL(const uint8_t Channel, + const uint8_t Source, + const uint32_t SourceFreq, + const uint32_t Frequency) + { + if (SourceFreq > Frequency) + return false; + + switch (Source) + { + case CLOCK_SRC_OSC0: + AVR32_PM.PLL[Channel].pllosc = 0; + break; + case CLOCK_SRC_OSC1: + AVR32_PM.PLL[Channel].pllosc = 1; + break; + default: + return false; + } + + AVR32_PM.PLL[Channel].pllmul = (Frequency / SourceFreq) ? (((Frequency / SourceFreq) - 1) / 2) : 0; + AVR32_PM.PLL[Channel].plldiv = 0; + AVR32_PM.PLL[Channel].pllen = true; + + while (!(AVR32_PM.poscsr & (1 << (AVR32_PM_POSCSR_LOCK0_OFFSET + Channel)))); + return true; + } + + /** Stops the given PLL of the UC3 microcontroller. + * + * \param[in] Channel Index of the PLL to stop. + */ + static inline void UC3CLK_StopPLL(const uint8_t Channel) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void UC3CLK_StopPLL(const uint8_t Channel) + { + AVR32_PM.PLL[Channel].pllen = false; + } + + /** Starts the given Generic Clock of the UC3 microcontroller, with the given options. + * + * \param[in] Channel Index of the Generic Clock to start. + * \param[in] Source Clock source for the Generic Clock, a value from \ref UC3_System_ClockSource_t. + * \param[in] SourceFreq Frequency of the Generic Clock's clock source, in Hz. + * \param[in] Frequency Target frequency of the Generic Clock's output. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the Generic Clock was successfully started, \c false if invalid parameters specified. + */ + static inline bool UC3CLK_StartGenericClock(const uint8_t Channel, + const uint8_t Source, + const uint32_t SourceFreq, + const uint32_t Frequency) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool UC3CLK_StartGenericClock(const uint8_t Channel, + const uint8_t Source, + const uint32_t SourceFreq, + const uint32_t Frequency) + { + if (Channel >= AVR32_PM_GCLK_NUM) + return false; + + if (SourceFreq < Frequency) + return false; + + switch (Source) + { + case CLOCK_SRC_OSC0: + AVR32_PM.GCCTRL[Channel].pllsel = false; + AVR32_PM.GCCTRL[Channel].oscsel = 0; + break; + case CLOCK_SRC_OSC1: + AVR32_PM.GCCTRL[Channel].pllsel = false; + AVR32_PM.GCCTRL[Channel].oscsel = 1; + break; + case CLOCK_SRC_PLL0: + AVR32_PM.GCCTRL[Channel].pllsel = true; + AVR32_PM.GCCTRL[Channel].oscsel = 0; + break; + case CLOCK_SRC_PLL1: + AVR32_PM.GCCTRL[Channel].pllsel = true; + AVR32_PM.GCCTRL[Channel].oscsel = 1; + break; + default: + return false; + } + + AVR32_PM.GCCTRL[Channel].diven = (SourceFreq > Frequency) ? true : false; + AVR32_PM.GCCTRL[Channel].div = (((SourceFreq / Frequency) - 1) / 2); + AVR32_PM.GCCTRL[Channel].cen = true; + + return true; + } + + /** Stops the given generic clock of the UC3 microcontroller. + * + * \param[in] Channel Index of the generic clock to stop. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the generic clock was successfully stopped, \c false if invalid parameters specified. + */ + static inline bool UC3CLK_StopGenericClock(const uint8_t Channel) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool UC3CLK_StopGenericClock(const uint8_t Channel) + { + if (Channel >= AVR32_PM_GCLK_NUM) + return false; + + AVR32_PM.GCCTRL[Channel].cen = false; + + return true; + } + + /** Sets the clock source for the main microcontroller core. The given clock source should be configured + * and ready for use before this function is called. + * + * This function will configure the FLASH controller's wait states automatically to suit the given clock source. + * + * \param[in] Source Clock source for the CPU core, a value from \ref UC3_System_ClockSource_t. + * \param[in] SourceFreq Frequency of the CPU core's clock source, in Hz. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the CPU core clock was successfully altered, \c false if invalid parameters specified. + */ + static inline bool UC3CLK_SetCPUClockSource(const uint8_t Source, + const uint32_t SourceFreq) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool UC3CLK_SetCPUClockSource(const uint8_t Source, + const uint32_t SourceFreq) + { + if (SourceFreq > AVR32_PM_CPU_MAX_FREQ) + return false; + + AVR32_FLASHC.FCR.fws = (SourceFreq > AVR32_FLASHC_FWS_0_MAX_FREQ) ? true : false; + + switch (Source) + { + #if defined(AVR32_PM_MCCTRL_MCSEL_SLOW) + case CLOCK_SRC_SLOW_CLK: + AVR32_PM.MCCTRL.mcsel = AVR32_PM_MCCTRL_MCSEL_SLOW; + break; + #endif + #if defined(AVR32_PM_MCCTRL_MCSEL_OSC0) + case CLOCK_SRC_OSC0: + AVR32_PM.MCCTRL.mcsel = AVR32_PM_MCCTRL_MCSEL_OSC0; + break; + #endif + #if defined(AVR32_PM_MCCTRL_MCSEL_PLL0) + case CLOCK_SRC_PLL0: + AVR32_PM.MCCTRL.mcsel = AVR32_PM_MCCTRL_MCSEL_PLL0; + break; + #endif + default: + return false; + } + + return true; + } + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/UC3/Exception.S b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/UC3/Exception.S new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..59f16f16f1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/UC3/Exception.S @@ -0,0 +1,128 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#if defined(__AVR32__) +#include <avr32/io.h> + +.section .exception_handlers, "ax", @progbits + +// ================= EXCEPTION TABLE ================ +.balign 0x200 +.global EVBA_Table +EVBA_Table: + +.org 0x000 +Exception_Unrecoverable_Exception: + rjmp $ +.org 0x004 +Exception_TLB_Multiple_Hit: + rjmp $ +.org 0x008 +Exception_Bus_Error_Data_Fetch: + rjmp $ +.org 0x00C +Exception_Bus_Error_Instruction_Fetch: + rjmp $ +.org 0x010 +Exception_NMI: + rjmp $ +.org 0x014 +Exception_Instruction_Address: + rjmp $ +.org 0x018 +Exception_ITLB_Protection: + rjmp $ +.org 0x01C +Exception_OCD_Breakpoint: + rjmp $ +.org 0x020 +Exception_Illegal_Opcode: + rjmp $ +.org 0x024 +Exception_Unimplemented_Instruction: + rjmp $ +.org 0x028 +Exception_Privilege_Violation: + rjmp $ +.org 0x02C +Exception_Floating_Point: + rjmp $ +.org 0x030 +Exception_Coprocessor_Absent: + rjmp $ +.org 0x034 +Exception_Data_Address_Read: + rjmp $ +.org 0x038 +Exception_Data_Address_Write: + rjmp $ +.org 0x03C +Exception_DTLB_Protection_Read: + rjmp $ +.org 0x040 +Exception_DTLB_Protection_Write: + rjmp $ +.org 0x044 +Exception_DTLB_Modified: + rjmp $ +.org 0x050 +Exception_ITLB_Miss: + rjmp $ +.org 0x060 +Exception_DTLB_Miss_Read: + rjmp $ +.org 0x070 +Exception_DTLB_Miss_Write: + rjmp $ +.org 0x100 +Exception_Supervisor_Call: + rjmp $ +// ============== END OF EXCEPTION TABLE ============= + +// ============= GENERAL INTERRUPT HANDLER =========== +.balign 4 +.irp Level, 0, 1, 2, 3 +Exception_INT\Level: + mov r12, \Level + call INTC_GetInterruptHandler + mov pc, r12 +.endr +// ========= END OF GENERAL INTERRUPT HANDLER ======== + +// ====== GENERAL INTERRUPT HANDLER OFFSET TABLE ====== +.balign 4 +.global Autovector_Table +Autovector_Table: +.irp Level, 0, 1, 2, 3 + .word ((AVR32_INTC_INT0 + \Level) << AVR32_INTC_IPR_INTLEVEL_OFFSET) | (Exception_INT\Level - EVBA_Table) +.endr +// === END OF GENERAL INTERRUPT HANDLER OFFSET TABLE === + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/UC3/InterruptManagement.c b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/UC3/InterruptManagement.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b99be24b97 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/UC3/InterruptManagement.c @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "../../Common/Common.h" +#if (ARCH == ARCH_UC3) + +#define __INCLUDE_FROM_INTMANAGEMENT_C +#include "InterruptManagement.h" + +/** Interrupt vector table, containing the ISR to call for each interrupt group */ +InterruptHandlerPtr_t InterruptHandlers[AVR32_INTC_NUM_INT_GRPS]; + +/** ISR for unhandled interrupt groups */ +ISR(Unhandled_Interrupt) +{ + for (;;); +} + +InterruptHandlerPtr_t INTC_GetInterruptHandler(const uint_reg_t InterruptLevel) +{ + return InterruptHandlers[AVR32_INTC.icr[AVR32_INTC_INT3 - InterruptLevel]]; +} + +void INTC_Init(void) +{ + for (uint8_t InterruptGroup = 0; InterruptGroup < AVR32_INTC_NUM_INT_GRPS; InterruptGroup++) + { + InterruptHandlers[InterruptGroup] = Unhandled_Interrupt; + AVR32_INTC.ipr[InterruptGroup] = Autovector_Table[AVR32_INTC_INT0]; + } + + __builtin_mtsr(AVR32_EVBA, (uintptr_t)&EVBA_Table); +} + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/UC3/InterruptManagement.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/UC3/InterruptManagement.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b051930370 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/UC3/InterruptManagement.h @@ -0,0 +1,174 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Interrupt Controller Driver for the AVR32 UC3 microcontrollers. + * + * Interrupt controller driver for the AVR32 UC3 microcontrollers, for the configuration of interrupt + * handlers within the device. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PlatformDrivers_UC3 + * \defgroup Group_PlatformDrivers_UC3Interrupts Interrupt Controller Driver - LUFA/Platform/UC3/InterruptManagement.h + * \brief Interrupt Controller Driver for the AVR32 UC3 microcontrollers. + * + * \section Sec_PlatformDrivers_UC3Interrupts_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - LUFA/Platform/UC3/InterruptManagement.c <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_PLATFORM)</i> + * - LUFA/Platform/UC3/Exception.S <i>(Makefile source module name: LUFA_SRC_PLATFORM)</i> + * + * \section Sec_PlatformDrivers_UC3Interrupts_ModDescription Module Description + * Interrupt controller driver for the AVR32 UC3 microcontrollers, for the configuration of interrupt + * handlers within the device. + * + * Usage Example: + * \code + * #include <LUFA/Platform/UC3/InterruptManagement.h> + * + * ISR(USB_Group_IRQ_Handler) + * { + * // USB group handler code here + * } + * + * void main(void) + * { + * INTC_Init(); + * INTC_RegisterGroupHandler(INTC_IRQ_GROUP(AVR32_USBB_IRQ), AVR32_INTC_INT0, USB_Group_IRQ_Handler); + * } + * \endcode + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _UC3_INTERRUPT_MANAGEMENT_H_ +#define _UC3_INTERRUPT_MANAGEMENT_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + #if !defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /* Type Defines: */ + typedef void (*InterruptHandlerPtr_t)(void); + + /* External Variables: */ + #if defined(__INCLUDE_FROM_INTMANAGEMENT_C) + extern const void EVBA_Table; + #endif + extern InterruptHandlerPtr_t InterruptHandlers[AVR32_INTC_NUM_INT_GRPS]; + extern const uint32_t Autovector_Table[]; + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Converts a given interrupt index into its associated interrupt group. + * + * \param[in] IRQIndex Index of the interrupt request to convert. + * + * \return Interrupt group number associated with the interrupt index. + */ + #define INTC_IRQ_GROUP(IRQIndex) (IRQIndex / 32) + + /** Converts a given interrupt index into its associated interrupt line. + * + * \param[in] IRQIndex Index of the interrupt request to convert. + * + * \return Interrupt line number associated with the interrupt index. + */ + #define INTC_IRQ_LINE(IRQIndex) (IRQIndex % 32) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Initializes the interrupt controller ready to handle interrupts. This must be called at the + * start of the user program before any interrupts are registered or enabled. + */ + void INTC_Init(void); + + /** Retrieves the associated interrupt handler for the interrupt group currently being fired. This + * is called directly from the exception handler routine before dispatching to the ISR. + * + * \param[in] InterruptLevel Priority level of the interrupt. + * + * \return Pointer to the associated interrupt handler function, or NULL if no handler set. + */ + InterruptHandlerPtr_t INTC_GetInterruptHandler(const uint_reg_t InterruptLevel); + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Registers a handler for a given interrupt group. On the AVR32 UC3 devices, interrupts are grouped by + * peripheral. To save on SRAM used, a single ISR handles all interrupt lines within a single group - to + * determine the exact line that has interrupted within the group ISR handler, use \ref INTC_GetGroupInterrupts(). + * + * If multiple interrupts with the same group are registered, the last registered handler will become the + * handler called for interrupts raised within that group. + * + * To obtain the group number of a specific interrupt index, use the \ref INTC_IRQ_GROUP() macro. + * + * \param[in] GroupNumber Group number of the interrupt group to register a handler for. + * \param[in] InterruptLevel Priority level for the specified interrupt, a \c AVR32_INTC_INT* mask. + * \param[in] Handler Address of the ISR handler for the interrupt group. + */ + static inline void INTC_RegisterGroupHandler(const uint16_t GroupNumber, + const uint8_t InterruptLevel, + const InterruptHandlerPtr_t Handler) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void INTC_RegisterGroupHandler(const uint16_t GroupNumber, + const uint8_t InterruptLevel, + const InterruptHandlerPtr_t Handler) + { + InterruptHandlers[GroupNumber] = Handler; + AVR32_INTC.ipr[GroupNumber] = Autovector_Table[InterruptLevel]; + } + + /** Retrieves the pending interrupts for a given interrupt group. The result of this function should be masked + * against interrupt request indexes converted to a request line number via the \ref INTC_IRQ_LINE() macro. To + * obtain the group number of a given interrupt request, use the \ref INTC_IRQ_GROUP() macro. + * + * \param[in] GroupNumber Group number of the interrupt group to check. + * + * \return Mask of pending interrupt lines for the given interrupt group. + */ + static inline uint_reg_t INTC_GetGroupInterrupts(const uint16_t GroupNumber) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline uint_reg_t INTC_GetGroupInterrupts(const uint16_t GroupNumber) + { + return AVR32_INTC.irr[GroupNumber]; + } + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/UC3/UC3ExperimentalInfo.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/UC3/UC3ExperimentalInfo.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8aadb3ed79 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/UC3/UC3ExperimentalInfo.txt @@ -0,0 +1 @@ +Please note that the UC3 architecture support is EXPERIMENTAL at this time, and may be non-functional/incomplete in some areas. Please refer to the Known Issues section of the LUFA manual.
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/XMEGA/ClockManagement.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/XMEGA/ClockManagement.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..eb941d9a30 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/XMEGA/ClockManagement.h @@ -0,0 +1,397 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Module Clock Driver for the AVR USB XMEGA microcontrollers. + * + * Clock management driver for the AVR USB XMEGA microcontrollers. This driver allows for the configuration + * of the various clocks within the device to clock the various peripherals. + */ + +/** \ingroup Group_PlatformDrivers_XMEGA + * \defgroup Group_PlatformDrivers_XMEGAClocks Clock Management Driver - LUFA/Platform/XMEGA/ClockManagement.h + * \brief Module Clock Driver for the AVR USB XMEGA microcontrollers. + * + * \section Sec_PlatformDrivers_XMEGAClocks_Dependencies Module Source Dependencies + * The following files must be built with any user project that uses this module: + * - None + * + * \section Sec_PlatformDrivers_XMEGAClocks_ModDescription Module Description + * Clock management driver for the AVR USB XMEGA microcontrollers. This driver allows for the configuration + * of the various clocks within the device to clock the various peripherals. + * + * Usage Example: + * \code + * #include <LUFA/Platform/XMEGA/ClockManagement.h> + * + * void main(void) + * { + * // Start the PLL to multiply the 2MHz RC oscillator to F_CPU and switch the CPU core to run from it + * XMEGACLK_StartPLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ, 2000000, F_CPU); + * XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(CLOCK_SRC_PLL); + * + * // Start the 32MHz internal RC oscillator and start the DFLL to increase it to F_USB using the USB SOF as a reference + * XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ); + * XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ, DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF, F_USB); + * } + * \endcode + * + * @{ + */ + +#ifndef _XMEGA_CLOCK_MANAGEMENT_H_ +#define _XMEGA_CLOCK_MANAGEMENT_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include "../../Common/Common.h" + + /* Enable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + extern "C" { + #endif + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Enum for the possible external oscillator frequency ranges. */ + enum XMEGA_Extern_OSC_ClockFrequency_t + { + EXOSC_FREQ_2MHZ_MAX = OSC_FRQRANGE_04TO2_gc, /**< External crystal oscillator equal to or slower than 2MHz. */ + EXOSC_FREQ_9MHZ_MAX = OSC_FRQRANGE_2TO9_gc, /**< External crystal oscillator equal to or slower than 9MHz. */ + EXOSC_FREQ_12MHZ_MAX = OSC_FRQRANGE_9TO12_gc, /**< External crystal oscillator equal to or slower than 12MHz. */ + EXOSC_FREQ_16MHZ_MAX = OSC_FRQRANGE_12TO16_gc, /**< External crystal oscillator equal to or slower than 16MHz. */ + }; + + /** Enum for the possible external oscillator startup times. */ + enum XMEGA_Extern_OSC_ClockStartup_t + { + EXOSC_START_6CLK = OSC_XOSCSEL_EXTCLK_gc, /**< Wait 6 clock cycles before startup (external clock). */ + EXOSC_START_32KCLK = OSC_XOSCSEL_32KHz_gc, /**< Wait 32K clock cycles before startup (32.768KHz crystal). */ + EXOSC_START_256CLK = OSC_XOSCSEL_XTAL_256CLK_gc, /**< Wait 256 clock cycles before startup. */ + EXOSC_START_1KCLK = OSC_XOSCSEL_XTAL_1KCLK_gc, /**< Wait 1K clock cycles before startup. */ + EXOSC_START_16KCLK = OSC_XOSCSEL_XTAL_16KCLK_gc, /**< Wait 16K clock cycles before startup. */ + }; + + /** Enum for the possible module clock sources. */ + enum XMEGA_System_ClockSource_t + { + CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ = 0, /**< Clock sourced from the Internal 2MHz RC Oscillator clock. */ + CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ = 1, /**< Clock sourced from the Internal 32MHz RC Oscillator clock. */ + CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32KHZ = 2, /**< Clock sourced from the Internal 32KHz RC Oscillator clock. */ + CLOCK_SRC_XOSC = 3, /**< Clock sourced from the External Oscillator clock. */ + CLOCK_SRC_PLL = 4, /**< Clock sourced from the Internal PLL clock. */ + }; + + /** Enum for the possible DFLL clock reference sources. */ + enum XMEGA_System_DFLLReference_t + { + DFLL_REF_INT_RC32KHZ = 0, /**< Reference clock sourced from the Internal 32KHz RC Oscillator clock. */ + DFLL_REF_EXT_RC32KHZ = 1, /**< Reference clock sourced from the External 32KHz RC Oscillator clock connected to TOSC pins. */ + DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF = 2, /**< Reference clock sourced from the USB Start Of Frame packets. */ + }; + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Write a value to a location protected by the XMEGA CCP protection mechanism. This function uses inline assembly to ensure that + * the protected address is written to within four clock cycles of the CCP key being written. + * + * \param[in] Address Address to write to, a memory address protected by the CCP mechanism + * \param[in] Value Value to write to the protected location + */ + static inline void XMEGACLK_CCP_Write(volatile void* Address, const uint8_t Value) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void XMEGACLK_CCP_Write(volatile void* Address, const uint8_t Value) + { + __asm__ __volatile__ ( + "out %0, __zero_reg__" "\n\t" /* Zero RAMPZ using fixed zero value register */ + "movw r30, %1" "\n\t" /* Copy address to Z register pair */ + "out %2, %3" "\n\t" /* Write key to CCP register */ + "st Z, %4" "\n\t" /* Indirectly write value to address */ + : /* No output operands */ + : /* Input operands: */ "m" (RAMPZ), "e" (Address), "m" (CCP), "r" (CCP_IOREG_gc), "r" (Value) + : /* Clobbered registers: */ "r30", "r31" + ); + } + + /** Starts the external oscillator of the XMEGA microcontroller, with the given options. This routine blocks until + * the oscillator is ready for use. + * + * \param[in] FreqRange Frequency range of the external oscillator, a value from \ref XMEGA_Extern_OSC_ClockFrequency_t. + * \param[in] Startup Startup time of the external oscillator, a value from \ref XMEGA_Extern_OSC_ClockStartup_t. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the external oscillator was successfully started, \c false if invalid parameters specified. + */ + static inline bool XMEGACLK_StartExternalOscillator(const uint8_t FreqRange, + const uint8_t Startup) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool XMEGACLK_StartExternalOscillator(const uint8_t FreqRange, + const uint8_t Startup) + { + OSC.XOSCCTRL = (FreqRange | ((Startup == EXOSC_START_32KCLK) ? OSC_X32KLPM_bm : 0) | Startup); + OSC.CTRL |= OSC_XOSCEN_bm; + + while (!(OSC.STATUS & OSC_XOSCRDY_bm)); + return true; + } + + /** Stops the external oscillator of the XMEGA microcontroller. */ + static inline void XMEGACLK_StopExternalOscillator(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void XMEGACLK_StopExternalOscillator(void) + { + OSC.CTRL &= ~OSC_XOSCEN_bm; + } + + /** Starts the given internal oscillator of the XMEGA microcontroller, with the given options. This routine blocks until + * the oscillator is ready for use. + * + * \param[in] Source Internal oscillator to start, a value from \ref XMEGA_System_ClockSource_t. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the internal oscillator was successfully started, \c false if invalid parameters specified. + */ + static inline bool XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(const uint8_t Source) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool XMEGACLK_StartInternalOscillator(const uint8_t Source) + { + switch (Source) + { + case CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ: + OSC.CTRL |= OSC_RC2MEN_bm; + while (!(OSC.STATUS & OSC_RC2MRDY_bm)); + return true; + case CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ: + OSC.CTRL |= OSC_RC32MEN_bm; + while (!(OSC.STATUS & OSC_RC32MRDY_bm)); + return true; + case CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32KHZ: + OSC.CTRL |= OSC_RC32KEN_bm; + while (!(OSC.STATUS & OSC_RC32KRDY_bm)); + return true; + default: + return false; + } + } + + /** Stops the given internal oscillator of the XMEGA microcontroller. + * + * \param[in] Source Internal oscillator to stop, a value from \ref XMEGA_System_ClockSource_t. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the internal oscillator was successfully stopped, \c false if invalid parameters specified. + */ + static inline bool XMEGACLK_StopInternalOscillator(const uint8_t Source) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool XMEGACLK_StopInternalOscillator(const uint8_t Source) + { + switch (Source) + { + case CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ: + OSC.CTRL &= ~OSC_RC2MEN_bm; + return true; + case CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ: + OSC.CTRL &= ~OSC_RC32MEN_bm; + return true; + case CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32KHZ: + OSC.CTRL &= ~OSC_RC32KEN_bm; + return true; + default: + return false; + } + } + + /** Starts the PLL of the XMEGA microcontroller, with the given options. This routine blocks until the PLL is ready for use. + * + * \attention The output frequency must be equal to or greater than the source frequency. + * + * \param[in] Source Clock source for the PLL, a value from \ref XMEGA_System_ClockSource_t. + * \param[in] SourceFreq Frequency of the PLL's clock source, in Hz. + * \param[in] Frequency Target frequency of the PLL's output. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the PLL was successfully started, \c false if invalid parameters specified. + */ + static inline bool XMEGACLK_StartPLL(const uint8_t Source, + const uint32_t SourceFreq, + const uint32_t Frequency) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool XMEGACLK_StartPLL(const uint8_t Source, + const uint32_t SourceFreq, + const uint32_t Frequency) + { + uint8_t MulFactor = (Frequency / SourceFreq); + + if (SourceFreq > Frequency) + return false; + + if (MulFactor > 31) + return false; + + switch (Source) + { + case CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ: + OSC.PLLCTRL = (OSC_PLLSRC_RC2M_gc | MulFactor); + break; + case CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ: + OSC.PLLCTRL = (OSC_PLLSRC_RC32M_gc | MulFactor); + break; + case CLOCK_SRC_XOSC: + OSC.PLLCTRL = (OSC_PLLSRC_XOSC_gc | MulFactor); + break; + default: + return false; + } + + OSC.CTRL |= OSC_PLLEN_bm; + + while (!(OSC.STATUS & OSC_PLLRDY_bm)); + return true; + } + + /** Stops the PLL of the XMEGA microcontroller. */ + static inline void XMEGACLK_StopPLL(void) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline void XMEGACLK_StopPLL(void) + { + OSC.CTRL &= ~OSC_PLLEN_bm; + } + + /** Starts the DFLL of the XMEGA microcontroller, with the given options. + * + * \param[in] Source RC Clock source for the DFLL, a value from \ref XMEGA_System_ClockSource_t. + * \param[in] Reference Reference clock source for the DFLL, an value from \ref XMEGA_System_DFLLReference_t. + * \param[in] Frequency Target frequency of the DFLL's output. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the DFLL was successfully started, \c false if invalid parameters specified. + */ + static inline bool XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(const uint8_t Source, + const uint8_t Reference, + const uint32_t Frequency) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool XMEGACLK_StartDFLL(const uint8_t Source, + const uint8_t Reference, + const uint32_t Frequency) + { + uint16_t DFLLCompare = (Frequency / 1024); + + switch (Source) + { + case CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ: + OSC.DFLLCTRL |= (Reference << OSC_RC2MCREF_bp); + DFLLRC2M.COMP1 = (DFLLCompare & 0xFF); + DFLLRC2M.COMP2 = (DFLLCompare >> 8); + DFLLRC2M.CTRL = DFLL_ENABLE_bm; + break; + case CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ: + OSC.DFLLCTRL |= (Reference << OSC_RC32MCREF_gp); + DFLLRC32M.COMP1 = (DFLLCompare & 0xFF); + DFLLRC32M.COMP2 = (DFLLCompare >> 8); + + if (Reference == DFLL_REF_INT_USBSOF) + { + NVM.CMD = NVM_CMD_READ_CALIB_ROW_gc; + DFLLRC32M.CALA = pgm_read_byte(offsetof(NVM_PROD_SIGNATURES_t, USBRCOSCA)); + DFLLRC32M.CALB = pgm_read_byte(offsetof(NVM_PROD_SIGNATURES_t, USBRCOSC)); + NVM.CMD = 0; + } + + DFLLRC32M.CTRL = DFLL_ENABLE_bm; + break; + default: + return false; + } + + return true; + } + + /** Stops the given DFLL of the XMEGA microcontroller. + * + * \param[in] Source RC Clock source for the DFLL to be stopped, a value from \ref XMEGA_System_ClockSource_t. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the DFLL was successfully stopped, \c false if invalid parameters specified. + */ + static inline bool XMEGACLK_StopDFLL(const uint8_t Source) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool XMEGACLK_StopDFLL(const uint8_t Source) + { + switch (Source) + { + case CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ: + DFLLRC2M.CTRL = 0; + break; + case CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ: + DFLLRC32M.CTRL = 0; + break; + default: + return false; + } + + return true; + } + + /** Sets the clock source for the main microcontroller core. The given clock source should be configured + * and ready for use before this function is called. + * + * \param[in] Source Clock source for the CPU core, a value from \ref XMEGA_System_ClockSource_t. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the CPU core clock was successfully altered, \c false if invalid parameters specified. + */ + static inline bool XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(const uint8_t Source) ATTR_ALWAYS_INLINE; + static inline bool XMEGACLK_SetCPUClockSource(const uint8_t Source) + { + uint8_t ClockSourceMask = 0; + + switch (Source) + { + case CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC2MHZ: + ClockSourceMask = CLK_SCLKSEL_RC2M_gc; + break; + case CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32MHZ: + ClockSourceMask = CLK_SCLKSEL_RC32M_gc; + break; + case CLOCK_SRC_INT_RC32KHZ: + ClockSourceMask = CLK_SCLKSEL_RC32K_gc; + break; + case CLOCK_SRC_XOSC: + ClockSourceMask = CLK_SCLKSEL_XOSC_gc; + break; + case CLOCK_SRC_PLL: + ClockSourceMask = CLK_SCLKSEL_PLL_gc; + break; + default: + return false; + } + + uint_reg_t CurrentGlobalInt = GetGlobalInterruptMask(); + GlobalInterruptDisable(); + + XMEGACLK_CCP_Write(&CLK.CTRL, ClockSourceMask); + + SetGlobalInterruptMask(CurrentGlobalInt); + + Delay_MS(1); + return (CLK.CTRL == ClockSourceMask); + } + + /* Disable C linkage for C++ Compilers: */ + #if defined(__cplusplus) + } + #endif + +#endif + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/XMEGA/XMEGAExperimentalInfo.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/XMEGA/XMEGAExperimentalInfo.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..42144aac48 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Platform/XMEGA/XMEGAExperimentalInfo.txt @@ -0,0 +1 @@ +Please note that the XMEGA architecture support is EXPERIMENTAL at this time, and may be non-functional/incomplete in some areas. Please refer to the Known Issues section of the LUFA manual.
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/Docbook/mshelp/README.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/Docbook/mshelp/README.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4f251cc0b8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/Docbook/mshelp/README.txt @@ -0,0 +1,13 @@ +This is a modified/updated version of the Microsoft HV1 Docbook transform, written by Morten Engelhardt Olsen, + +Originally posted at http://sourceforge.net/p/docbook/feature-requests/461/, this has been further updated by Morten to make it compatible with more recent DocBook versions. + + --------------------------- +/ This documentation system \ +\ is udderly ridiculous! / + --------------------------- + \ ^__^ + \ (oo)\_______ + (__)\ )\/\ + ||----w | + || || diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/Docbook/mshelp/docbook.xsl b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/Docbook/mshelp/docbook.xsl new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..03b81feafc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/Docbook/mshelp/docbook.xsl @@ -0,0 +1,58 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?> +<xsl:stylesheet + xmlns:xsl="http://www.w3.org/1999/XSL/Transform" + xmlns:d="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" + xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" + exclude-result-prefixes="xsl d" + version="1.0"> + + <xsl:import href="../xhtml/chunk.xsl"/> + <xsl:import href="../xhtml/highlight.xsl"/> + + <!-- + Based on the normal xhtml templates, all overrides applicable to + xhtml is applicable to HV1. + --> + + <xsl:import href="hv1-common.xsl"/> + + <!-- + Choose if links should be generated using ms-xhelp (default) or + the more verbose ms.help type. The latter requires product.name, + product.version and product.locale to be set + --> + <xsl:param name="use.mshelp.links" select="0"/> + + <!-- + Name of target product. If specified then each page is + marked with this product. This is usualy set during + install time. + --> + <xsl:param name="product.name" select="''" /> + + <!-- + Name of target version. If specified then each page is + marked with this version. This is usualy set during + install time. + --> + <xsl:param name="product.version" select="''" /> + + <!-- + Locale for the help. Should always be set + --> + <xsl:param name="product.locale" select="'en-US'" /> + + <!-- + Self branding. Gives access for chunks to load + it's own branding package during runtime + --> + <xsl:param name="topic.selfbrand" select="1"/> + + + <!-- Use doctitle for olinks --> + <xsl:param name="olink.doctitle" select="'yes'" /> + + <!-- Enable source code highlighting--> + <xsl:param name="highlight.source" select="1"/> + +</xsl:stylesheet> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/Docbook/mshelp/hv1-common.xsl b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/Docbook/mshelp/hv1-common.xsl new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b6f2610680 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/Docbook/mshelp/hv1-common.xsl @@ -0,0 +1,664 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?> +<xsl:stylesheet xmlns:xsl="http://www.w3.org/1999/XSL/Transform" + xmlns:d="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" + xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" + exclude-result-prefixes="d" + version="1.0"> + + + <!-- no separate HTML page with index as this is binary in hv1 --> + <xsl:param name="generate.index" select="0"/> + + + <!-- Generate help tags in header --> + <xsl:template name="user.head.content"> + <xsl:param name="node" select="''" /> + <xsl:variable name="up" select="parent::*"/> + + <!-- Locale should be first Help tag--> + <meta name="Microsoft.Help.Locale"> + <xsl:attribute name="content"> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="$product.locale and product.locale != ''"> + <xsl:value-of select="$product.locale"/> + </xsl:when> + <xsl:otherwise> + <xsl:text>en-US</xsl:text> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + </xsl:attribute> + </meta> + + <!-- Specify locale for this chunk. Should probably query xml:lang --> + <meta name="Microsoft.Help.TopicLocale"> + <xsl:attribute name="content"> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="@xml:lang"> + <xsl:value-of select="@xml:lang"/> + </xsl:when> + <xsl:when test="$product.locale and product.locale != ''"> + <xsl:value-of select="$product.locale"/> + </xsl:when> + <xsl:otherwise> + <xsl:text>en-US</xsl:text> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + </xsl:attribute> + </meta> + + <!-- This is the unique ID for this page --> + <meta name="Microsoft.Help.Id"> + <xsl:attribute name="content"> + <xsl:call-template name="hv1.toc.id"/> + </xsl:attribute> + </meta> + + <!-- The ID of the parent TOC node (-1 is root) --> + <meta name="Microsoft.Help.TocParent"> + <xsl:attribute name="content"> + <xsl:call-template name="hv1.toc.parent.id"> + <xsl:with-param name="up" select="$up"/> + </xsl:call-template> + </xsl:attribute> + </meta> + + <!-- For all pages with the same parent, the order is set by TocOrder --> + <meta name="Microsoft.Help.TocOrder"> + <xsl:attribute name="content"> + <xsl:value-of select="1+count(preceding-sibling::chapter|preceding-sibling::section)"/> + </xsl:attribute> + </meta> + + <!-- boolean to indicate if this page is allowed to load custom branding --> + <meta name="Microsoft.Help.SelfBranded"> + <xsl:attribute name="content"> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="$topic.selfbrand"> + <xsl:text>true</xsl:text> + </xsl:when> + <xsl:otherwise> + <xsl:text>false</xsl:text> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + </xsl:attribute> + </meta> + + <!-- + Insert description meta element. This is shown in searches and indexes + --> + + <xsl:variable name="description"> + <xsl:call-template name="hv1.description"/> + </xsl:variable> + <xsl:if test="$description != ''"> + <meta name="Description"> + <xsl:attribute name="content"> + <xsl:call-template name="hv1.description"/> + </xsl:attribute> + </meta> + </xsl:if> + + <!-- Display version of page --> + <xsl:variable name="display.version"> + <xsl:call-template name="hv1.display.version"/> + </xsl:variable> + <xsl:if test="$display.version != ''"> + <meta name="Microsoft.Help.DisplayVersion"> + <xsl:attribute name="content"> + <xsl:value-of select="$display.version"/> + </xsl:attribute> + </meta> + </xsl:if> + + <!-- + Content type is used to distinguish between multiple topics with same id. + Usualy to have multiple versions available + --> + <!-- + <meta name="Microsoft.Help.ContentType"> + <xsl:attribute name="content"> + TODO: implement + </xsl:attribute> + </meta> + --> + + + <!-- If a product name is given, then mark each header with this name--> + <xsl:if test="$product.name and $product.name != ''"> + <meta name="Microsoft.Help.Product"> + <xsl:attribute name="content"> + <xsl:value-of select="$product.name"/> + </xsl:attribute> + </meta> + </xsl:if> + + <!-- If a version is given, then mark each header with version--> + <xsl:if test="$product.version and $product.version != ''"> + <meta name="Microsoft.Help.ProductVersion"> + <xsl:attribute name="content"> + <xsl:value-of select="$product.version"/> + </xsl:attribute> + </meta> + </xsl:if> + + <!-- + Insert all keywords for this chunk. These are used + by the help runtime to generate indexes and refine search + --> + <xsl:call-template name="hv1.keywords" /> + + <!-- + Insert all F1 ids for this chunk. This is used + by the help runtime to resolve F1 queries + --> + <xsl:call-template name="hv1.f1" /> + </xsl:template> + + + <!-- There are links from ToC pane to bibliodivs, so there must be anchor --> + <xsl:template match="bibliodiv/title"> + <h3 class="{name(.)}"> + <xsl:call-template name="anchor"> + <xsl:with-param name="node" select=".."/> + <xsl:with-param name="conditional" select="0"/> + </xsl:call-template> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </h3> + </xsl:template> + + <!-- + Template to get a page id. + + Needs to be unique in the target help system; microsoft uses UUIDs for this. + To avoid UUIDs and generate-id (only unique in current xml fragment), + we do + <root.filename> + + <last ancestor title> + + <second last ancestor title> + + .... + <self title>, where different types of sections/fragments + may be prefixed with a type identifier. + + This should generate a fairly specific/unique ID. + --> + <xsl:template name="get.id.from.pagename"> + <xsl:param name="target" /> + <xsl:value-of select="$root.filename"/> + <xsl:variable name="id.of.document"> + <xsl:apply-templates select="$target" mode="recursive-chunk-id"/> + </xsl:variable> + <xsl:variable name="titleWithSpace"> + <xsl:value-of select="key('id',$id.of.document)/title"/> + </xsl:variable> + <xsl:value-of select="translate($id.of.document,' ','')" /> + </xsl:template> + + <!-- template that returns the page id used above --> + <xsl:template match="*" mode="recursive-chunk-id"> + <xsl:param name="recursive" select="false()"/> + + <!-- returns the filename of a chunk --> + <xsl:variable name="ischunk"> + <xsl:call-template name="chunk"/> + </xsl:variable> + + <xsl:variable name="dbhtml-filename"> + <xsl:call-template name="pi.dbhtml_filename"/> + </xsl:variable> + + <xsl:variable name="filename"> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="$dbhtml-filename != ''"> + <xsl:value-of select="$dbhtml-filename"/> + </xsl:when> + <!-- if this is the root element, use the root.filename --> + <xsl:when test="not(parent::*) and $root.filename != ''"> + <xsl:value-of select="$root.filename"/> + <!-- <xsl:value-of select="$html.ext"/> --> + </xsl:when> + <!-- Special case --> + <xsl:when test="self::legalnotice and not($generate.legalnotice.link = 0)"> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="(@id or @xml:id) and not($use.id.as.filename = 0)"> + <!-- * if this legalnotice has an ID, then go ahead and use --> + <!-- * just the value of that ID as the basename for the file --> + <!-- * (that is, without prepending an "ln-" too it) --> + <xsl:value-of select="(@id|@xml:id)[1]"/> + <!-- <xsl:value-of select="$html.ext"/>--> + </xsl:when> + <xsl:otherwise> + <!-- * otherwise, if this legalnotice does not have an ID, --> + <!-- * then we generate an ID... --> + <xsl:variable name="id"> + <xsl:call-template name="object.id"/> + </xsl:variable> + <!-- * ...and then we take that generated ID, prepend an --> + <!-- * "ln-" to it, and use that as the basename for the file --> + <!-- <xsl:value-of select="concat('ln-',$id,$html.ext)"/>--> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + </xsl:when> + <!-- if there's no dbhtml filename, and if we're to use IDs as --> + <!-- filenames, then use the ID to generate the filename. --> + <xsl:when test="(@id or @xml:id) and $use.id.as.filename != 0"> + <xsl:value-of select="(@id|@xml:id)[1]"/> + <!-- <xsl:value-of select="$html.ext"/>--> + </xsl:when> + <xsl:otherwise/> + </xsl:choose> + </xsl:variable> + + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="$ischunk='0'"> + <!-- if called on something that isn't a chunk, walk up... --> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="count(parent::*)>0"> + <xsl:apply-templates mode="recursive-chunk-id" select="parent::*"> + <xsl:with-param name="recursive" select="$recursive"/> + </xsl:apply-templates> + </xsl:when> + <!-- unless there is no up, in which case return "" --> + <xsl:otherwise/> + </xsl:choose> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="not($recursive) and $filename != ''"> + <!-- if this chunk has an explicit name, use it --> + <xsl:value-of select="$filename"/> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="self::set"> + <xsl:value-of select="$root.filename"/> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="self::book"> + <xsl:text>bk</xsl:text> + <xsl:number level="any" format="01"/> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="self::article"> + <xsl:if test="/set"> + <!-- in a set, make sure we inherit the right book info... --> + <xsl:apply-templates mode="recursive-chunk-id" select="parent::*"> + <xsl:with-param name="recursive" select="true()"/> + </xsl:apply-templates> + </xsl:if> + + <xsl:text>ar</xsl:text> + <xsl:number level="any" format="01" from="book"/> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="self::preface"> + <xsl:if test="/set"> + <!-- in a set, make sure we inherit the right book info... --> + <xsl:apply-templates mode="recursive-chunk-id" select="parent::*"> + <xsl:with-param name="recursive" select="true()"/> + </xsl:apply-templates> + </xsl:if> + + <xsl:text>pr</xsl:text> + <xsl:number level="any" format="01" from="book"/> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="self::chapter"> + <xsl:if test="/set"> + <!-- in a set, make sure we inherit the right book info... --> + <xsl:apply-templates mode="recursive-chunk-id" select="parent::*"> + <xsl:with-param name="recursive" select="true()"/> + </xsl:apply-templates> + </xsl:if> + + <xsl:text>ch</xsl:text> + <xsl:number level="any" format="01" from="book"/> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="self::appendix"> + <xsl:if test="/set"> + <!-- in a set, make sure we inherit the right book info... --> + <xsl:apply-templates mode="recursive-chunk-id" select="parent::*"> + <xsl:with-param name="recursive" select="true()"/> + </xsl:apply-templates> + </xsl:if> + + <xsl:text>ap</xsl:text> + <xsl:number level="any" format="a" from="book"/> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="self::part"> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="/set"> + <!-- in a set, make sure we inherit the right book info... --> + <xsl:apply-templates mode="recursive-chunk-id" select="parent::*"> + <xsl:with-param name="recursive" select="true()"/> + </xsl:apply-templates> + </xsl:when> + <xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + + <xsl:text>pt</xsl:text> + <xsl:number level="any" format="01" from="book"/> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="self::reference"> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="/set"> + <!-- in a set, make sure we inherit the right book info... --> + <xsl:apply-templates mode="recursive-chunk-id" select="parent::*"> + <xsl:with-param name="recursive" select="true()"/> + </xsl:apply-templates> + </xsl:when> + <xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + + <xsl:text>rn</xsl:text> + <xsl:number level="any" format="01" from="book"/> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="self::refentry"> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="parent::reference"> + <xsl:apply-templates mode="recursive-chunk-id" select="parent::*"> + <xsl:with-param name="recursive" select="true()"/> + </xsl:apply-templates> + </xsl:when> + <xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + + <xsl:text>re</xsl:text> + <xsl:number level="any" format="01" from="book"/> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="self::colophon"> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="/set"> + <!-- in a set, make sure we inherit the right book info... --> + <xsl:apply-templates mode="recursive-chunk-id" select="parent::*"> + <xsl:with-param name="recursive" select="true()"/> + </xsl:apply-templates> + </xsl:when> + <xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + + <xsl:text>co</xsl:text> + <xsl:number level="any" format="01" from="book"/> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="self::sect1 + or self::sect2 + or self::sect3 + or self::sect4 + or self::sect5 + or self::section"> + <xsl:apply-templates mode="recursive-chunk-id" select="parent::*"> + <xsl:with-param name="recursive" select="true()"/> + </xsl:apply-templates> + <xsl:text>s</xsl:text> + <xsl:number format="01"/> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="self::bibliography"> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="/set"> + <!-- in a set, make sure we inherit the right book info... --> + <xsl:apply-templates mode="recursive-chunk-id" select="parent::*"> + <xsl:with-param name="recursive" select="true()"/> + </xsl:apply-templates> + </xsl:when> + <xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + + <xsl:text>bi</xsl:text> + <xsl:number level="any" format="01" from="book"/> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="self::glossary"> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="/set"> + <!-- in a set, make sure we inherit the right book info... --> + <xsl:apply-templates mode="recursive-chunk-id" select="parent::*"> + <xsl:with-param name="recursive" select="true()"/> + </xsl:apply-templates> + </xsl:when> + <xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + + <xsl:text>go</xsl:text> + <xsl:number level="any" format="01" from="book"/> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="self::index"> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="/set"> + <!-- in a set, make sure we inherit the right book info... --> + <xsl:apply-templates mode="recursive-chunk-id" select="parent::*"> + <xsl:with-param name="recursive" select="true()"/> + </xsl:apply-templates> + </xsl:when> + <xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + + <xsl:text>ix</xsl:text> + <xsl:number level="any" format="01" from="book"/> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="self::setindex"> + <xsl:text>si</xsl:text> + <xsl:number level="any" format="01" from="set"/> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:otherwise> + <xsl:text>chunk-filename-error-</xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="name(.)"/> + <xsl:number level="any" format="01" from="set"/> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + </xsl:template> + + <!-- Main template that generates internal links --> + <xsl:template name="href.target"> + <xsl:param name="context" select="."/> + <xsl:param name="object" select="."/> + <xsl:param name="toc-context" select="."/> + + <xsl:variable name="id"> + <xsl:call-template name="get.id.from.pagename"> + <xsl:with-param name="target" select="$object"/> + </xsl:call-template> + </xsl:variable> + + <xsl:variable name="href"> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="$use.mshelp.links"> + <!-- Generate a ms.help type link--> + <xsl:if test="$product.name = ''"> + <xsl:message terminate="yes"> + $product.name needs to be set to generate ms.help style links + </xsl:message> + </xsl:if> + <xsl:if test="$product.version = ''"> + <xsl:message terminate="yes"> + $product.version needs to be set to generate ms.help style links + </xsl:message> + </xsl:if> + <xsl:if test="$product.locale = ''"> + <xsl:message terminate="yes"> + $product.locale needs to be set to generate ms.help style links + </xsl:message> + </xsl:if> + + <xsl:text>ms.help?method=page&id=</xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="$id"/> + <xsl:text>&product=</xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="$product.name"/> + <xsl:text>&productVersion=</xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="$product.version"/> + <xsl:text>&locale=</xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="$product.locale"/> + <!-- Append the jump id if the current object has an id--> + <xsl:if test="$object[@id or @xml:id]"> + <xsl:text>#</xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="$object/@id|$object/@xml:id"/> + </xsl:if> + </xsl:when> + <xsl:otherwise> + <!-- Generate ms-xhelp type links. Default--> + <xsl:text>ms-xhelp:///?Id=</xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="$id"/> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + </xsl:variable> + <xsl:value-of select="$href"/> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="*" mode="common.html.attributes"> + <xsl:param name="class" select="local-name(.)"/> + <xsl:param name="inherit" select="0"/> + + <!-- + Workaround for known issue with HelpLibAgent + Comment from Bruce Belson: + <pre> tags get their whitespace mangled by the Help Library Agent, + unless the non-standard attribute xml:space="preserve" is added to the pre element. + --> + <xsl:if test="$class = 'programlisting' or $class = 'verbatim' or $class = 'litterallayout' or $class = 'screen'"> + <xsl:attribute name="xml:space">preserve</xsl:attribute> + </xsl:if> + + <xsl:call-template name="generate.html.lang"/> + <xsl:call-template name="dir"> + <xsl:with-param name="inherit" select="$inherit"/> + </xsl:call-template> + <xsl:apply-templates select="." mode="class.attribute"> + <xsl:with-param name="class" select="$class"/> + </xsl:apply-templates> + </xsl:template> + + + <xsl:template name="hv1.display.version"> + <xsl:apply-templates mode="title.markup" select="ancestor-or-self::book"/> + <xsl:if test="ancestor-or-self::chapter"> + <xsl:text> - </xsl:text> + <xsl:apply-templates mode="title.markup" select="ancestor-or-self::chapter"/> + </xsl:if> + </xsl:template> + + + <!-- Generate a meta element for each keyword in chunk --> + <xsl:template name="hv1.keywords"> + <xsl:variable name="is.chunk"> + <xsl:call-template name="chunk"> + <xsl:with-param name="node" select="."/> + </xsl:call-template> + </xsl:variable> + + <xsl:for-each select=".//indexterm[$is.chunk = '0'] | + (./indexterm | *[not(self::section or self::preface or self::book or self::chapter)]//indexterm)[$is.chunk = '1']"> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="primary != ''"> + <meta name="Microsoft.Help.Keywords"> + <xsl:attribute name="content"> + <xsl:choose> + <!-- This concats the primary and secondary togheter, separated by colon if there exists + a tertiary element --> + <xsl:when test="tertiary"> + <xsl:value-of select="primary/text()" /> + <xsl:text>: </xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="secondary/text()" /> + <xsl:text>, </xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="tertiary/text()" /> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:otherwise> + <xsl:for-each select="primary/text() | secondary/text()"> + <xsl:value-of select="." /> + <xsl:if test="not(position() = last())">, </xsl:if> + </xsl:for-each> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + </xsl:attribute> + </meta> + </xsl:when> + <xsl:otherwise/> + </xsl:choose> + </xsl:for-each> + </xsl:template> + + <!-- Generate a F1 meta element for each indexterm with an ID (used as F1 id) --> + <xsl:template name="hv1.f1"> + <xsl:variable name="is.chunk"> + <xsl:call-template name="chunk"> + <xsl:with-param name="node" select="."/> + </xsl:call-template> + </xsl:variable> + + <xsl:variable name="id"> + <xsl:call-template name="hv1.toc.id"/> + </xsl:variable> + + <xsl:for-each select=".//indexterm[$is.chunk = '0'] | + (./indexterm | *[not(self::section or self::preface or self::book or self::chapter)]//indexterm)[$is.chunk = '1']"> + <xsl:if test="@id|@xml:id"> + <meta name="Microsoft.Help.F1"> + <xsl:attribute name="content"> + <xsl:value-of select="(@id|@xml:id)[1]" /> + </xsl:attribute> + </meta> + </xsl:if> + </xsl:for-each> + </xsl:template> + + <!-- ID used for to resolution. Using default ID --> + <xsl:template name="hv1.toc.id"> + <xsl:variable name="href"> + <xsl:call-template name="get.id.from.pagename"> + <xsl:with-param name="target" select="."/> + </xsl:call-template> + </xsl:variable> + <xsl:value-of select="$href"/> + </xsl:template> + + <!-- Determine parent id (if top level -> -1) --> + <xsl:template name="hv1.toc.parent.id"> + <xsl:param name="up" select="''"/> + <xsl:variable name="href"> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="$up"> + <!-- I have a parent --> + <xsl:call-template name="get.id.from.pagename"> + <xsl:with-param name="target" select="$up"/> + </xsl:call-template> + </xsl:when> + <xsl:otherwise> + <xsl:text>-1</xsl:text> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + </xsl:variable> + <xsl:value-of select="$href"/> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template name="hv1.description"> + <xsl:variable name="content"> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="abstract|d:abstract|d:info/d:abstract|bookinfo/abstract|sectioninfo/abstract|articleinfo/abstract|partinfo/abstract"> + <xsl:value-of select="(abstract|d:abstract|d:info/d:abstract|bookinfo/abstract|sectioninfo/abstract|articleinfo/abstract|partinfo/abstract)[1]"/> + </xsl:when> + <xsl:when test="child::para"> + <xsl:value-of select="substring(normalize-space(child::para[1]), 0, 150)"/> + </xsl:when> + <xsl:otherwise/> + </xsl:choose> + </xsl:variable> + <xsl:if test="$content != ''"> + <xsl:value-of select="concat($content, '...')"/> + </xsl:if> + </xsl:template> + + +</xsl:stylesheet> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/Docbook/placeholder.txt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/Docbook/placeholder.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c017acfd75 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/Docbook/placeholder.txt @@ -0,0 +1 @@ +Copy the Docbook XSLT docbook-xsl-1.78.1 release contents into this directory (i.e. with the root Docbook files in the current folder). The Docbook releases can be found at http://sourceforge.net/projects/docbook/files/docbook-xsl/ .
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/HV1/helpcontentsetup.msha b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/HV1/helpcontentsetup.msha new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bd1d7ee219 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/HV1/helpcontentsetup.msha @@ -0,0 +1,27 @@ +<!-- + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +--> + +<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"> + <head> + <title>LUFA Help</title> + </head> + <body class="vendor-book"> + <div class="details"> + <span class="vendor">FourWalledCubicle</span> + <span class="product">LUFA</span> + <span class="name">LUFA Help</span> + <span class="locale">en-us</span> + </div> + <div class="package-list"> + <div class="package"> + <span class="name">lufa_studio_help.mshc</span> + <a class="current-link" href="lufa_studio_help.mshc">lufa_studio_help.mshc</a> + </div> + </div> + </body> +</html> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/HV1/lufa_docbook_transform.xslt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/HV1/lufa_docbook_transform.xslt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..26c1d378e2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/HV1/lufa_docbook_transform.xslt @@ -0,0 +1,806 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?> + +<xsl:stylesheet xmlns:xsl="http://www.w3.org/1999/XSL/Transform" version="1.0"> + + <xsl:output method="xml" indent="no"/> + + <xsl:template name="generate.book.title"> + <xsl:text>LUFA Library</xsl:text> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template name="generate.book.id"> + <xsl:param name="book.title"/> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="@id"> + <xsl:value-of select="@id"/> + </xsl:when> + <xsl:otherwise> + <xsl:value-of select="translate($book.title, ' ','')"/> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template name="generate.index.id"> + <xsl:param name="name"/> + <xsl:variable name="book.title"> + <xsl:call-template name="generate.book.title"/> + </xsl:variable> + <xsl:variable name="book.id"> + <xsl:call-template name="generate.book.id"> + <xsl:with-param name="book.title" select="$book.title"/> + </xsl:call-template> + </xsl:variable> + + <indexterm id="{$name}"> + <primary> + <xsl:value-of select="$book.title"/> + </primary> + <secondary> + <xsl:value-of select="$name"/> + </secondary> + </indexterm> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="doxygen"> + <xsl:variable name="book.title"> + <xsl:call-template name="generate.book.title"/> + </xsl:variable> + + <xsl:variable name="book.id"> + <xsl:call-template name="generate.book.id"> + <xsl:with-param name="book.title" select="$book.title"/> + </xsl:call-template> + </xsl:variable> + + <book id="{$book.id}"> + <title> + <xsl:value-of select="$book.title"/> + </title> + + <!-- Add index chapter --> + <xsl:apply-templates select="compounddef[@kind = 'page' and @id = 'indexpage']"> + <xsl:with-param name="element.type" select="'chapter'"/> + <xsl:with-param name="page.title" select="'Library Information'"/> + </xsl:apply-templates> + + <!-- Add free-floating chapters --> + <xsl:apply-templates select="compounddef[@kind = 'page' and not(@id = 'indexpage') and not(//innerpage/@refid = @id)]"> + <xsl:with-param name="element.type" select="'chapter'"/> + </xsl:apply-templates> + + <!-- Add Modules chapter --> + <chapter> + <title>Modules</title> + <xsl:apply-templates select="compounddef[@kind = 'group' and not(//innergroup/@refid = @id)]"/> + </chapter> + </book> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="compounddef[@kind = 'page']"> + <xsl:param name="element.type" select="'section'"/> + <xsl:param name="page.title" select="title"/> + + <xsl:element name="{$element.type}"> + <xsl:attribute name="id"> + <xsl:value-of select="@id"/> + </xsl:attribute> + + <xsl:variable name="name"> + <xsl:text>LUFA.</xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="translate(compoundname, '_', '.')"/> + </xsl:variable> + + <xsl:call-template name="generate.index.id"> + <xsl:with-param name="name" select="$name"/> + </xsl:call-template> + + <title> + <xsl:value-of select="$page.title"/> + </title> + + <xsl:apply-templates select="detaileddescription"/> + + <xsl:if test="not(innerpage) and count(detaileddescription//sect1)"> + <para> + <emphasis role="bold">Subsections:</emphasis> + <itemizedlist> + <xsl:for-each select="detaileddescription//sect1"> + <listitem> + <link linkend="{@id}"> + <xsl:value-of select="title"/> + </link> + </listitem> + </xsl:for-each> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </xsl:if> + + <xsl:for-each select="innerpage"> + <xsl:apply-templates select="ancestor::*/compounddef[@kind = 'page' and @id = current()/@refid]"/> + </xsl:for-each> + </xsl:element> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="compounddef[@kind = 'group']"> + <section id="{@id}"> + <title> + <xsl:value-of select="title"/> + </title> + + <xsl:variable name="name"> + <xsl:text>LUFA.</xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="translate(compoundname, '_', '.')"/> + </xsl:variable> + + <xsl:call-template name="generate.index.id"> + <xsl:with-param name="name" select="$name"/> + </xsl:call-template> + + <xsl:apply-templates select="detaileddescription"/> + + <xsl:if test="count(innergroup)"> + <para> + <emphasis role="bold">Subgroups:</emphasis> + <itemizedlist> + <xsl:for-each select="innergroup"> + <listitem> + <link linkend="{@refid}"> + <xsl:value-of select="text()"/> + </link> + </listitem> + </xsl:for-each> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </xsl:if> + + <xsl:apply-templates select="sectiondef"/> + + <xsl:for-each select="innerclass"> + <xsl:apply-templates select="ancestor::*/compounddef[@id = current()/@refid]"/> + </xsl:for-each> + + <xsl:for-each select="innergroup"> + <xsl:apply-templates select="ancestor::*/compounddef[@kind = 'group' and @id = current()/@refid]"/> + </xsl:for-each> + </section> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="compounddef[@kind = 'struct' or @kind = 'union']"> + <xsl:variable name="name" select="compoundname"/> + + <section id="{@id}" xreflabel="{$name}"> + <title> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="@kind = 'struct'"> + <xsl:text>Struct </xsl:text> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="@kind = 'union'"> + <xsl:text>Union </xsl:text> + </xsl:when> + </xsl:choose> + + <xsl:value-of select="$name"/> + </title> + + <xsl:call-template name="generate.index.id"> + <xsl:with-param name="name" select="$name"/> + </xsl:call-template> + + <xsl:apply-templates select="detaileddescription"/> + + <xsl:for-each select="sectiondef[@kind = 'public-attrib']"> + <table> + <title> + <xsl:value-of select="$name"/> + </title> + + <tgroup cols="3"> + <thead> + <row> + <entry>Type</entry> + <entry>Name</entry> + <entry>Description</entry> + </row> + </thead> + + <tbody> + <xsl:for-each select="memberdef"> + <row id="{@id}" xreflabel="{name}"> + <entry> + <xsl:value-of select="type"/> + </entry> + <entry> + <xsl:value-of select="name"/> + <xsl:if test="starts-with(argsstring, '[')"> + <xsl:text>[]</xsl:text> + </xsl:if> + + <xsl:variable name="struct.element.name"> + <xsl:value-of select="$name"/> + <xsl:text>.</xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="name"/> + </xsl:variable> + + <xsl:call-template name="generate.index.id"> + <xsl:with-param name="name" select="$struct.element.name"/> + </xsl:call-template> + </entry> + <entry> + <xsl:apply-templates select="detaileddescription"/> + </entry> + </row> + </xsl:for-each> + </tbody> + </tgroup> + </table> + </xsl:for-each> + </section> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="memberdef[@kind = 'function']"> + <section id="{@id}" xreflabel="{name}"> + <title> + <xsl:text>Function </xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="name"/> + <xsl:text>()</xsl:text> + </title> + + <xsl:call-template name="generate.index.id"> + <xsl:with-param name="name" select="name"/> + </xsl:call-template> + + <para> + <emphasis role="italic"> + <xsl:value-of select="briefdescription"/> + </emphasis> + </para> + + <programlisting language="c"> + <emphasis role="keyword"> + <xsl:value-of select="type"/> + </emphasis> + <xsl:text> </xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="name"/> + <xsl:text>(</xsl:text> + + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="not(param[1]/declname)"> + <emphasis role="keyword">void</emphasis> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:otherwise> + <xsl:for-each select="param"> + <xsl:if test="position() > 1"> + <xsl:text>,</xsl:text> + </xsl:if> + <xsl:text> 	</xsl:text> + <emphasis role="keyword"> + <xsl:value-of select="type"/> + </emphasis> + <xsl:text> </xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="declname"/> + </xsl:for-each> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + + <xsl:text>)</xsl:text> + </programlisting> + + <xsl:apply-templates select="detaileddescription"/> + </section> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="memberdef[@kind = 'enum']"> + <section id="{@id}" xreflabel="{name}"> + <title> + <xsl:text>Enum </xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="name"/> + </title> + + <xsl:call-template name="generate.index.id"> + <xsl:with-param name="name" select="name"/> + </xsl:call-template> + + <xsl:apply-templates select="detaileddescription"/> + + <table> + <title>Members</title> + <tgroup cols="2"> + <thead> + <row> + <entry>Enum Value</entry> + <entry>Description</entry> + </row> + </thead> + + <tbody> + <xsl:for-each select="enumvalue"> + <row> + <entry> + <para id="{@id}" xreflabel="{name}"> + <xsl:value-of select="name"/> + + <xsl:call-template name="generate.index.id"> + <xsl:with-param name="name" select="name"/> + </xsl:call-template> + </para> + </entry> + <entry> + <xsl:apply-templates select="detaileddescription"/> + </entry> + </row> + </xsl:for-each> + </tbody> + </tgroup> + </table> + </section> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="memberdef[@kind = 'define']"> + <section id="{@id}" xreflabel="{name}"> + <title> + <xsl:text>Macro </xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="name"/> + </title> + + <xsl:call-template name="generate.index.id"> + <xsl:with-param name="name" select="name"/> + </xsl:call-template> + + <programlisting language="c"> + <emphasis role="preprocessor"> + <xsl:text>#define </xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="name"/> + <xsl:if test="count(param) > 0"> + <xsl:text>(</xsl:text> + <xsl:for-each select="param/defname"> + <xsl:if test="position() > 1"> + <xsl:text>,</xsl:text> + </xsl:if> + <xsl:value-of select="."/> + </xsl:for-each> + <xsl:text>)</xsl:text> + </xsl:if> + <xsl:text> </xsl:text> + + <!-- Split long macro definitions across multiple lines --> + <xsl:if test="(string-length(initializer) > 50) or (count(param) > 0)"> + <xsl:text>\ 	</xsl:text> + </xsl:if> + + <xsl:value-of select="initializer"/> + </emphasis> + <xsl:text> </xsl:text> + </programlisting> + + <xsl:apply-templates select="detaileddescription"/> + </section> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="memberdef[@kind = 'typedef']"> + <section id="{@id}" xreflabel="{name}"> + <title> + <xsl:text>Type </xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="name"/> + </title> + + <xsl:call-template name="generate.index.id"> + <xsl:with-param name="name" select="name"/> + </xsl:call-template> + + <programlisting language="c"> + <emphasis role="keyword"> + <xsl:text>typedef </xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="type"/> + </emphasis> + <xsl:text> </xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="name"/> + <xsl:text> </xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="argsstring"/> + </programlisting> + + <xsl:apply-templates select="detaileddescription"/> + </section> + </xsl:template> + + + <xsl:template match="memberdef[@kind = 'variable']"> + <section id="{@id}" xreflabel="{name}"> + <title> + <xsl:text>Variable </xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="name"/> + </title> + + <xsl:call-template name="generate.index.id"> + <xsl:with-param name="name" select="name"/> + </xsl:call-template> + + <programlisting language="c"> + <emphasis role="keyword"> + <xsl:value-of select="type"/> + </emphasis> + <xsl:text> </xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="name"/> + </programlisting> + + <xsl:apply-templates select="detaileddescription"/> + </section> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="linebreak | simplesectsep"> + <!-- MUST be on two separate lines, as this is a *literal* newline --> + <literallayout> + </literallayout> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="verbatim"> + <programlisting> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </programlisting> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="sectiondef"> + <para> + <xsl:value-of select="description"/> + </para> + + <xsl:apply-templates select="memberdef"/> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="simplesect" mode="struct"> + <footnote> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </footnote> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="simplesect"> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="@kind = 'par'"> + <note> + <title> + <xsl:value-of select="title"/> + </title> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </note> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="@kind = 'return'"> + <note> + <title>Returns</title> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </note> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="@kind = 'warning'"> + <warning> + <title>Warning</title> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </warning> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="@kind = 'pre'"> + <note> + <title>Precondition</title> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </note> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="@kind = 'see'"> + <note> + <title>See also</title> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </note> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:when test="@kind = 'note'"> + <note> + <title>Note</title> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </note> + </xsl:when> + + </xsl:choose> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="parameterlist[@kind = 'param']"> + <table> + <title>Parameters</title> + <tgroup cols="3"> + <thead> + <row> + <entry>Data Direction</entry> + <entry>Parameter Name</entry> + <entry>Description</entry> + </row> + </thead> + <tbody> + <xsl:for-each select="parameteritem"> + <row> + <xsl:apply-templates select="."/> + </row> + </xsl:for-each> + </tbody> + </tgroup> + </table> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="parameterlist[@kind = 'retval']"> + <table> + <title>Return Values</title> + <tgroup cols="2"> + <thead> + <row> + <entry>Return Value</entry> + <entry>Description</entry> + </row> + </thead> + <tbody> + <xsl:for-each select="parameteritem"> + <row> + <xsl:apply-templates select="."/> + </row> + </xsl:for-each> + </tbody> + </tgroup> + </table> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="parameteritem"> + <xsl:if test="parent::parameterlist/@kind = 'param'"> + <entry> + <para> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="not(descendant::parametername/@direction)"> + <emphasis role="italic">?</emphasis> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:otherwise> + <emphasis role="bold"> + [<xsl:value-of select="descendant::parametername/@direction"/>] + </emphasis> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + </para> + </entry> + </xsl:if> + + <entry> + <para> + <xsl:value-of select="parameternamelist/parametername"/> + </para> + </entry> + + <entry> + <xsl:apply-templates select="parameterdescription"/> + </entry> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="parameterdescription"> + <para> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </para> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="type"> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="bold"> + <emphasis role="bold"> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </emphasis> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="emphasis"> + <emphasis role="italic"> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </emphasis> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="small"> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="mdash | ndash"> + <!-- Doxygen bug; double dashed are replaced with single HTML dash + entities, even in verbatim-like <tt> sections --> + <xsl:text>--</xsl:text> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="computeroutput | preformatted"> + <computeroutput> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </computeroutput> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="codeline"> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="ulink"> + <ulink url="{@url}"> + <xsl:value-of select="."/> + </ulink> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="superscript"> + <superscript> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </superscript> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="subscript"> + <subscript> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </subscript> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="para"> + <para> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </para> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="ref"> + <xsl:choose> + <!-- Don't show links inside program listings --> + <xsl:when test="ancestor::programlisting"> + <xsl:value-of select="."/> + </xsl:when> + + <!-- Don't show links to file compound definitions, as they are discarded --> + <xsl:when test="ancestor::*/compounddef[@kind = 'file' and @id = current()/@refid]"> + <xsl:value-of select="."/> + </xsl:when> + + <!-- Show links outside program listings --> + <xsl:otherwise> + <link linkend="{@refid}"> + <xsl:value-of select="text()"/> + </link> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="entry"> + <entry> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </entry> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="table[caption]"> + <table> + <title> + <xsl:value-of select="caption"/> + </title> + + <tgroup cols="{@cols}"> + <thead> + <xsl:apply-templates select="row[entry/@thead = 'yes']"/> + </thead> + + <tbody> + <xsl:apply-templates select="row[entry/@thead != 'yes']"/> + </tbody> + </tgroup> + </table> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="table[not(caption)]"> + <informaltable> + <tgroup cols="{@cols}"> + <thead> + <xsl:apply-templates select="row[entry/@thead = 'yes']"/> + </thead> + + <tbody> + <xsl:apply-templates select="row[entry/@thead != 'yes']"/> + </tbody> + </tgroup> + </informaltable> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="row"> + <row> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </row> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="itemizedlist"> + <itemizedlist> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </itemizedlist> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="orderedlist"> + <orderedlist> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </orderedlist> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="listitem"> + <listitem> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </listitem> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="programlisting"> + <programlisting language="c"> + <xsl:for-each select="codeline[position() > 1 or highlight]"> + <xsl:apply-templates select="."/> + <xsl:text> </xsl:text> + </xsl:for-each> + </programlisting> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="highlight"> + <emphasis role="{@class}"> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </emphasis> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="highlight[1]/text()"> + <xsl:choose> + <xsl:when test="substring(., 1, 1) = '*'"> + <xsl:value-of select="substring(., 2)"/> + </xsl:when> + + <xsl:otherwise> + <xsl:value-of select="."/> + </xsl:otherwise> + </xsl:choose> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="sp[ancestor::codeline]"> + <xsl:text> </xsl:text> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="image"> + <mediaobject> + <imageobject> + <imagedata align="center"> + <xsl:attribute name="fileref"> + <xsl:text>images/</xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="@name"/> + </xsl:attribute> + </imagedata> + </imageobject> + </mediaobject> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="detaileddescription"> + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="sect1 | sect2 | sect3 | sect4 | sect5 | sect6 | sect7 | sect8 | sect9"> + <section> + <xsl:if test="@id"> + <xsl:attribute name="id"> + <xsl:value-of select="@id"/> + </xsl:attribute> + </xsl:if> + + <title> + <xsl:value-of select="title"/> + </title> + + <xsl:apply-templates/> + </section> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="anchor"> + <xsl:if test="@id"> + <indexterm id="{@id}"/> + </xsl:if> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="title"/> + + <xsl:template match="htmlonly"/> + + <xsl:template match="*"> + <xsl:message>NO XSL TEMPLATE MATCH: <xsl:value-of select="local-name()"/></xsl:message> + </xsl:template> + +</xsl:stylesheet> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/HV1/lufa_helpcontentsetup_transform.xslt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/HV1/lufa_helpcontentsetup_transform.xslt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c9ff58f597 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/HV1/lufa_helpcontentsetup_transform.xslt @@ -0,0 +1,47 @@ +<!-- + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +--> + +<!-- Atmel Studio HV1 Setup XHTML transform file --> + +<!-- Updates a helpcontentsetup.msha document to add appropriate version + information. --> +<xsl:stylesheet xmlns:xsl="http://www.w3.org/1999/XSL/Transform" xmlns:xhtml="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" version="1.0"> + <xsl:output method="xml" omit-xml-declaration="yes"/> + + <!-- Need to input the LUFA help package filename for later use --> + <xsl:param name="help-package-filename"/> + + <!-- Recursively match and copy/process all nodes/attributes --> + <xsl:template match="node()"> + <xsl:copy> + <xsl:copy-of select="@*"/> + <xsl:apply-templates select="node()"/> + </xsl:copy> + </xsl:template> + + <!-- Update the LUFA help package file name --> + <xsl:template match="xhtml:div[@class='package']/xhtml:span[@class='name']"> + <xsl:copy> + <xsl:copy-of select="@class"/> + + <xsl:value-of select="$help-package-filename"/> + </xsl:copy> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="xhtml:div[@class='package']/xhtml:a[@class='current-link']"> + <xsl:copy> + <xsl:copy-of select="@class"/> + + <xsl:attribute name="href"> + <xsl:value-of select="$help-package-filename"/> + </xsl:attribute> + + <xsl:value-of select="$help-package-filename"/> + </xsl:copy> + </xsl:template> +</xsl:stylesheet> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/HV1/lufa_hv1_transform.xslt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/HV1/lufa_hv1_transform.xslt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e7e230166d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/HV1/lufa_hv1_transform.xslt @@ -0,0 +1,45 @@ +<!--
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+-->
+
+<!-- Docbook XML to Microsoft Help Viewer 1.0 transform file -->
+
+<xsl:stylesheet xmlns:xsl="http://www.w3.org/1999/XSL/Transform" version="1.0">
+
+ <xsl:import href="../Docbook/mshelp/docbook.xsl"/>
+
+ <xsl:output method="xml" indent="no"/>
+
+ <xsl:template match="emphasis[@role = 'keyword' or @role = 'keywordtype' or @role = 'keywordflow']">
+ <span class="hl-keyword" style="color: #0079C1">
+ <xsl:apply-templates/>
+ </span>
+ </xsl:template>
+
+ <xsl:template match="emphasis[@role = 'stringliteral' or @role = 'charliteral']">
+ <span class="hl-string" style="color: #800000">
+ <xsl:apply-templates/>
+ </span>
+ </xsl:template>
+
+ <xsl:template match="emphasis[@role = 'comment']">
+ <em class="hl-comment" style="color: #008000">
+ <xsl:apply-templates/>
+ </em>
+ </xsl:template>
+
+ <xsl:template match="emphasis[@role = 'preprocessor']">
+ <span class="hl-preprocessor" style="color: #A000A0">
+ <xsl:apply-templates/>
+ </span>
+ </xsl:template>
+
+ <xsl:template match="emphasis[@role = 'normal' and ancestor::programlisting]">
+ <xsl:apply-templates />
+ </xsl:template>
+
+</xsl:stylesheet>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/HV1/lufa_studio_help_styling.css b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/HV1/lufa_studio_help_styling.css new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a4a025cc8b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/HV1/lufa_studio_help_styling.css @@ -0,0 +1,53 @@ +/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+*/
+
+.programlisting {
+ display: block;
+ margin-left: 15px;
+ padding: 10px;
+ background-color: #f4f4f4;
+ border: 1px solid #aaaaaa;
+ font-family: "Consolas", "Courier New", sans-serif;
+ }
+
+ code {
+ background-color: #f4f4f4;
+ font-family: "Consolas", "Courier New", sans-serif;
+ }
+
+.note, .warning, .tip {
+ display: block;
+ margin-left: 15px;
+ padding-left: 10px;
+ padding-bottom: 5px;
+ background-color: #f4f4f4;
+ border: 1px solid #aaaaaa;
+}
+
+table {
+ border: 1px solid #aaaaaa;
+ border-collapse: collapse;
+ margin-left: 15px;
+ font-size: 10pt;
+}
+
+table thead {
+ background-color: #f4f4f4;
+}
+
+table thead th {
+ padding: 5px;
+}
+
+table tbody td {
+ padding: 5px;
+}
+
+ul {
+ padding-left: 20px;
+}
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/LUFA.dll b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/LUFA.dll Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..369c78178b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/LUFA.dll diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/LUFA.pkgdef b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/LUFA.pkgdef Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b1b2f943b8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/LUFA.pkgdef diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/[Content_Types].xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/[Content_Types].xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..05ef8b6ba4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/[Content_Types].xml @@ -0,0 +1,13 @@ +<Types xmlns="http://schemas.openxmlformats.org/package/2006/content-types">
+ <Default Extension="vsixmanifest" ContentType="text/xml"/>
+ <Default Extension="cache" ContentType="text/xml"/>
+ <Default Extension="png" ContentType="application/octet-stream"/>
+ <Default Extension="txt" ContentType="text/plain"/>
+ <Default Extension="xml" ContentType="text/xml"/>
+ <Default Extension="zip" ContentType="application/octet-stream"/>
+ <Default Extension="dll" ContentType="application/octet-stream" />
+ <Default Extension="pkgdef" ContentType="text/plain" />
+ <Default Extension="htm" ContentType="text/html" />
+ <Default Extension="msha" ContentType="text/html" />
+ <Default Extension="mshc" ContentType="application/octet-stream"/>
+</Types>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/asf-manifest.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/asf-manifest.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..794fd689e1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/asf-manifest.xml @@ -0,0 +1,18 @@ +<AsfContentProvider Version="1.0.0">
+ <Identifier Id="0e160d5c-e331-48d9-850b-e0387912171b">
+ <Org>FourWalledCubicle</Org>
+ <ShortName>LUFA</ShortName>
+ <Author>Dean Camera</Author>
+ <Description/>
+ <FollowFolderStructure>True</FollowFolderStructure>
+ </Identifier>
+ <AsfContent Type="zip" Path="contents.zip">
+ <Content>
+ <Version>0</Version>
+ <HelpURL/>
+ <Locator/>
+ <DbXMLPath>content.xml.cache</DbXMLPath>
+ <Description/>
+ </Content>
+ </AsfContent>
+</AsfContentProvider>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/extension.vsixmanifest b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/extension.vsixmanifest new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f155618b73 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/extension.vsixmanifest @@ -0,0 +1,32 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+
+<Vsix xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xmlns:xsd="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema" Version="1.0.0" xmlns="http://schemas.microsoft.com/developer/vsx-schema/2010">
+ <Identifier Id="FourWalledCubicle.LUFA.0e160d5c-e331-48d9-850b-e0387912171b">
+ <Name>LUFA Library</Name>
+ <Author>Dean Camera</Author>
+ <Version>0</Version>
+ <MoreInfoUrl>http://www.lufa-lib.org</MoreInfoUrl>
+ <Description xml:space="preserve">LUFA, the Lightweight USB Framework for AVRs.</Description>
+
+ <License>License.txt</License>
+ <Icon>LUFA_thumb.png</Icon>
+ <PreviewImage>LUFA.png</PreviewImage>
+
+ <SupportedProducts>
+ <IsolatedShell Version="7.0">AtmelStudio</IsolatedShell>
+ </SupportedProducts>
+
+ <SupportedFrameworkRuntimeEdition MinVersion="4.0" MaxVersion="4.5"/>
+ <Locale>1033</Locale>
+
+ <AllUsers>false</AllUsers>
+ </Identifier>
+
+ <References/>
+
+ <Content>
+ <VsPackage>LUFA.pkgdef</VsPackage>
+ <CustomExtension Type="MSHelp">helpcontentsetup.msha</CustomExtension>
+ <CustomExtension Type="asf-manifest">asf-manifest.xml</CustomExtension>
+ </Content>
+</Vsix>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/generate_caches.py b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/generate_caches.py new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ab787e8ec3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/generate_caches.py @@ -0,0 +1,38 @@ +"""
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+"""
+
+import sys
+sys.path.append("ProjectGenerator")
+
+
+def show_message(message):
+ print("[Project Generator] %s" % message)
+ sys.stdout.flush()
+
+
+def main(lufa_root_path):
+ try:
+ from asf_avrstudio5_interface import PythonFacade
+ except ImportError:
+ print("Fatal Error: The ASF project generator is missing.")
+ return 1
+
+ p = PythonFacade(lufa_root_path)
+
+ show_message("Checking database sanity...")
+ p.check_extension_database_sanity(lufa_root_path)
+
+ show_message("Building cache files...")
+ p.generate_extension_cache_files(lufa_root_path)
+
+ show_message("Cache files created.")
+ return 0
+
+
+if __name__ == "__main__":
+ sys.exit(main(sys.argv[1]))
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/lufa_asfmanifest_transform.xslt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/lufa_asfmanifest_transform.xslt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..00f552c9c9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/lufa_asfmanifest_transform.xslt @@ -0,0 +1,36 @@ +<!-- + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +--> + +<!-- Atmel Studio framework VSIX XML transform file --> + +<!-- Updates an asf-manifest.xml document to add appropriate version + information. --> +<xsl:stylesheet xmlns:xsl="http://www.w3.org/1999/XSL/Transform" version="1.0"> + <xsl:output method="xml" omit-xml-declaration="yes"/> + + <!-- Need to input the LUFA version for later use --> + <xsl:param name="lufa-version"/> + + <!-- Recursively match and copy/process all nodes/attributes --> + <xsl:template match="@*|node()"> + <xsl:copy> + <xsl:apply-templates select="@*|node()"/> + </xsl:copy> + </xsl:template> + + <!-- Update the LUFA version to the version passed as a parameter --> + <xsl:template match="Version"> + <xsl:copy> + <xsl:value-of select="substring($lufa-version, 1, 2)"/> + <xsl:text>.</xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="substring($lufa-version, 3, 2)"/> + <xsl:text>.</xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="substring($lufa-version, 5, 2)"/> + </xsl:copy> + </xsl:template> +</xsl:stylesheet> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/lufa_vsmanifest_transform.xslt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/lufa_vsmanifest_transform.xslt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1198dd9dd6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/VSIX/lufa_vsmanifest_transform.xslt @@ -0,0 +1,33 @@ +<!-- + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +--> + +<!-- Atmel Studio framework VSIX XML transform file --> + +<!-- Updates the version element of a Visual Studio VSIX manifest file to the + value passed as a parameter to the stylesheet transform --> +<xsl:stylesheet xmlns:xsl="http://www.w3.org/1999/XSL/Transform" xmlns:vs="http://schemas.microsoft.com/developer/vsx-schema/2010" version="1.0"> + <xsl:output method="xml" omit-xml-declaration="yes"/> + + <!-- Need to input the extension version for later use --> + <xsl:param name="extension-version"/> + + <!-- Recursively match and copy/process all nodes/attributes --> + <xsl:template match="@*|node()"> + <xsl:copy> + <xsl:apply-templates select="@*|node()"/> + </xsl:copy> + </xsl:template> + + <!-- Update the extension version to the version passed as a parameter --> + <xsl:template match="vs:Version"> + <xsl:copy> + <xsl:value-of select="$extension-version"/> + </xsl:copy> + </xsl:template> + +</xsl:stylesheet> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/XDK/lufa_extension_transform.xslt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/XDK/lufa_extension_transform.xslt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c3fb82294a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/XDK/lufa_extension_transform.xslt @@ -0,0 +1,68 @@ +<!-- + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +--> + +<!-- Atmel Studio framework Extension XML transform file --> + +<!-- Creates an extension.xml document from a given manifest list of XML files, + and adds appropriate documentation base URI entries and version + information. --> +<xsl:stylesheet xmlns:xsl="http://www.w3.org/1999/XSL/Transform" version="1.0"> + <xsl:output method="xml" omit-xml-declaration="yes"/> + + <!-- Store the LUFA version mentioned in the root node for later use --> + <xsl:param name="lufa-version" select="lufa-manifest/@version"/> + + <!-- Read manifest list and then process all FDK nodes in the referenced + document --> + <xsl:template match="lufa-manifest"> + <xsl:comment>This file has been automatically generated from the LUFA Atmel Studio integration XML files.</xsl:comment> + + <extension-container xmlversion="2.0"> + <xsl:for-each select="xml-source"> + <xsl:apply-templates select="document(@filename)/lufa/extension-container/*"/> + </xsl:for-each> + </extension-container> + </xsl:template> + + <!-- Recursively match and copy/process all nodes/attributes --> + <xsl:template match="@*|node()"> + <xsl:copy> + <xsl:apply-templates select="@*|node()"/> + </xsl:copy> + </xsl:template> + + <!-- Update the extension version to the version of LUFA being used --> + <xsl:template match="extension/@version"> + <xsl:attribute name="version"> + <xsl:value-of select="substring($lufa-version, 1, 2)"/> + <xsl:text>.</xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="substring($lufa-version, 3, 2)"/> + <xsl:text>.</xsl:text> + <xsl:value-of select="substring($lufa-version, 5, 2)"/> + </xsl:attribute> + </xsl:template> + + <!-- Update the extension online help URLs to the version of LUFA being + used --> + <xsl:template match="online-help/*/@baseurl"> + <xsl:attribute name="baseurl"> + <xsl:value-of select="current()"/> + <xsl:value-of select="$lufa-version"/> + <xsl:text>/html/</xsl:text> + </xsl:attribute> + </xsl:template> + + <xsl:template match="online-help/index-page/@url"> + <xsl:attribute name="url"> + <xsl:value-of select="current()"/> + <xsl:value-of select="$lufa-version"/> + <xsl:text>/html/</xsl:text> + </xsl:attribute> + </xsl:template> + +</xsl:stylesheet> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/XDK/lufa_filelist_transform.xslt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/XDK/lufa_filelist_transform.xslt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2998b879f0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/XDK/lufa_filelist_transform.xslt @@ -0,0 +1,35 @@ +<!-- + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +--> + +<!-- Atmel Studio framework Module XML transform file --> + +<!-- Outputs a flat file list of all source files referenced in all modules of + the input manifest XML file, so that they can be checked for existence. --> +<xsl:stylesheet xmlns:xsl="http://www.w3.org/1999/XSL/Transform" version="1.0"> + <xsl:output method="xml" omit-xml-declaration="yes"/> + + <!-- Read manifest list, add a comment to indicate the source filename + and then process all ASF nodes in the referenced document --> + <xsl:template match="lufa-manifest"> + <xsl:for-each select="xml-source"> + <xsl:comment>Sourced from <xsl:value-of select="@filename"/></xsl:comment> + <xsl:apply-templates select="document(@filename)/lufa/asf/*"/> + </xsl:for-each> + </xsl:template> + + <!-- Recursively match and process all nodes/attributes --> + <xsl:template match="@*|node()"> + <xsl:apply-templates select="@*|node()"/> + </xsl:template> + + <!-- Match source file nodes, output filename --> + <xsl:template match="build[@type='c-source']|build[@type='header-file']|build[@type='distribute']"> + <xsl:value-of select="@value"/> + <xsl:text>
</xsl:text> + </xsl:template> +</xsl:stylesheet> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/XDK/lufa_indent_transform.xslt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/XDK/lufa_indent_transform.xslt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6c22ff94cc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/XDK/lufa_indent_transform.xslt @@ -0,0 +1,23 @@ +<!-- + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +--> + +<!-- Atmel Studio framework XML transform file --> + +<!-- Indents a given XML document to match the node hierarchy. --> +<xsl:stylesheet version="1.0" xmlns:xsl="http://www.w3.org/1999/XSL/Transform"> + <xsl:output method="xml" omit-xml-declaration="yes" indent="yes"/> + + <!-- Remove all white-space on all elements so that they can be indented --> + <xsl:strip-space elements="*"/> + + <!-- Match the root node and copy, so that the output will be a correctly + indented version of the input document --> + <xsl:template match="/"> + <xsl:copy-of select="."/> + </xsl:template> +</xsl:stylesheet> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/XDK/lufa_module_transform.xslt b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/XDK/lufa_module_transform.xslt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0ab44e7a18 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/XDK/lufa_module_transform.xslt @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +<!-- + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +--> + +<!-- Atmel Studio framework Module XML transform file --> + +<!-- Creates an asf.xml module document from a given manifest list of XML files, + and adds appropriate documentation links by cross-referencing the Doxygen + tag output file to map Doxygen group names to generated filenames. --> +<xsl:stylesheet xmlns:xsl="http://www.w3.org/1999/XSL/Transform" version="1.0"> + <xsl:output method="xml" omit-xml-declaration="yes"/> + + <!-- Store the LUFA Doxygen tag filename mentioned in the root node for later use --> + <xsl:param name="lufa-doxygen-tagfile" select="lufa-manifest/@tagfile"/> + + <!-- Store the LUFA Doxygen documentation filename mentioned in the root node for later use --> + <xsl:param name="lufa-doxygen-docfile" select="lufa-manifest/@docfile"/> + + <!-- Read manifest list, add a comment to indicate the source filename + and then copy/process all ASF nodes in the referenced document --> + <xsl:template match="lufa-manifest"> + <xsl:comment>This file has been automatically generated from the LUFA Atmel Studio integration XML files.</xsl:comment> + + <asf xmlversion="1.0"> + <xsl:for-each select="xml-source"> + <xsl:comment>Sourced from <xsl:value-of select="@filename"/></xsl:comment> + <xsl:apply-templates select="document(@filename)/lufa/asf/*"/> + </xsl:for-each> + </asf> + </xsl:template> + + <!-- Recursively match and copy/process all nodes/attributes --> + <xsl:template match="@*|node()"> + <xsl:copy> + <xsl:apply-templates select="@*|node()"/> + </xsl:copy> + </xsl:template> + + <!-- For Doxygen entry point nodes we need to convert them into help link + nodes instead and add descriptions, so that they show up as links in + Studio correctly --> + <xsl:template match="build[@type='doxygen-entry-point']"> + <!-- select-by-config entries should not have a help link --> + <xsl:if test="not(parent::select-by-config)"> + <build type="online-help" subtype="module-help-page-append"> + <xsl:attribute name="value"> + <!-- Extract filename of the HTML file that contains the documentation for this module from the Doxgen tag file --> + <xsl:value-of select="document($lufa-doxygen-tagfile)/tagfile/compound[name=current()/@value]/filename"/> + </xsl:attribute> + </build> + </xsl:if> + + <!-- Modules inside a select-by-config entries should not have a help link --> + <xsl:if test="not(parent::module and ../parent::select-by-config)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + <!-- Extract brief description of the module from the Doxygen combined XML documentation file --> + <xsl:value-of select="document($lufa-doxygen-docfile)/doxygen/compounddef[compoundname=current()/@value]/briefdescription/para"/> + </info> + </xsl:if> + </xsl:template> + +</xsl:stylesheet> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c838949865 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa.xml @@ -0,0 +1,96 @@ +<!--
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+-->
+
+<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file -->
+
+<lufa>
+ <extension-container>
+ <extension uuid="0e160d5c-e331-48d9-850b-e0387912171b" org="FourWalledCubicle" shortname="LUFA" version="" fullname="Lightweight USB Framework for AVRs (LUFA)">
+ <author name="Dean Camera" website="http://www.lufa-lib.org/" email="dean@fourwalledcubicle.com"/>
+ <description>Lightweight USB Framework for AVRs (LUFA), a USB software stack/framework.</description>
+ <icon-image path="LUFA/DoxygenPages/Images/LUFA_thumb.png"/>
+ <preview-image path="LUFA/DoxygenPages/Images/LUFA.png"/>
+ <license caption="LUFA License" path="LUFA/License.txt"/>
+ <release-notes caption="LUFA Information" url="http://www.lufa-lib.org"/>
+ <online-help>
+ <index-page caption="LUFA Documentation" url="http://www.lufa-lib.org/documentation/"/>
+ <module-help-page scheme="append" baseurl="http://www.lufa-lib.org/documentation/"/>
+ <module-guide-page scheme="append" baseurl="http://www.lufa-lib.org/documentation/"/>
+ </online-help>
+ <dependencies/>
+ </extension>
+ </extension-container>
+
+ <asf>
+ <device-alias-map name="lufa_avr8">
+ <device-support value="at90usb82"/>
+ <device-support value="atmega8u2"/>
+ <device-support value="at90usb162"/>
+ <device-support value="atmega16u2"/>
+ <device-support value="atmega16u4"/>
+ <device-support value="atmega32u2"/>
+ <device-support value="atmega32u4"/>
+ <device-support value="at90usb646"/>
+ <device-support value="at90usb647"/>
+ <device-support value="at90usb1286"/>
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ </device-alias-map>
+
+ <device-alias-map name="lufa_xmega">
+ <device-support value="atxmega16a4u"/>
+ <device-support value="atxmega32a4u"/>
+ <device-support value="atxmega64a4u"/>
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a4u"/>
+ <device-support value="atxmega64a3u"/>
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a3u"/>
+ <device-support value="atxmega192a3u"/>
+ <device-support value="atxmega256a3u"/>
+ <device-support value="atxmega256a3bu"/>
+ <device-support value="atxmega128a1u"/>
+ <device-support value="atxmega64b3"/>
+ <device-support value="atxmega128b3"/>
+ <device-support value="atxmega64b1"/>
+ <device-support value="atxmega128b1"/>
+ <device-support value="atxmega64c3"/>
+ <device-support value="atxmega128c3"/>
+ <device-support value="atxmega192c3"/>
+ <device-support value="atxmega256c3"/>
+ <device-support value="atxmega384c3"/>
+ <device-support value="atxmega16c4"/>
+ </device-alias-map>
+
+ <device-alias-map name="lufa_uc3">
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a364"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a364s"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a464"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a464s"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3b064"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3b164"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a0128"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a1128"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a3128"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a3128s"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a4128"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a4128s"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3b0128"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3b1128"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a0256"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a1256"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a3256"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a3256s"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a4256"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a4256s"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3b0256"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3b1256"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a0512"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a1512"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3b0512"/>
+ <device-support value="at32uc3b1512"/>
+ </device-alias-map>
+ </asf>
+</lufa>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_common.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_common.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b72f84cd9d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_common.xml @@ -0,0 +1,34 @@ +<!--
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+-->
+
+<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file -->
+
+<lufa>
+ <asf>
+ <module type="service" id="lufa.common" caption="LUFA Common Infrastructure">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_Common"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Version.h"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="license" value="License.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Common/Common.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Common/Architectures.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Common/ArchitectureSpecific.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Common/Attributes.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Common/BoardTypes.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Common/CompilerSpecific.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Common/Endianness.h"/>
+ </module>
+ </asf>
+</lufa>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_board.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_board.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bd0359f683 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_board.xml @@ -0,0 +1,114 @@ +<!--
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+-->
+
+<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file -->
+
+<lufa>
+ <asf>
+ <board id="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8" vendor="LUFA" caption="AVR8 Architecture">
+ <device-support value="mega"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.info"/>
+ </board>
+
+ <board id="lufa.boards.dummy.xmega" vendor="LUFA" caption="XMEGA Architecture">
+ <device-support value="xmega"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.info"/>
+ </board>
+
+ <board id="lufa.boards.dummy.uc3" vendor="LUFA" caption="UC3 Architecture">
+ <device-support value="uc3"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.info"/>
+ </board>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board.info" caption="LUFA Board Hardware Information Driver">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/Board/Board.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board.leds" caption="LUFA Board LED Driver">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_LEDs"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/Board/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board.buttons" caption="LUFA Board Buttons Driver">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_Buttons"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/Board/Buttons.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board.dataflash" caption="LUFA Board Dataflash Driver">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_Dataflash"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board.joystick" caption="LUFA Board Joystick Driver">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_Joystick"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/Board/Joystick.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board.temperature" caption="LUFA Board Temperature Sensor Driver">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_Temperature"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.adc"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/Board/Temperature.c"/>
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/Board/Temperature.h"/>
+ </module>
+ </asf>
+</lufa>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_board_names.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_board_names.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..69a38c5f70 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_board_names.xml @@ -0,0 +1,853 @@ +<!--
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+-->
+
+<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file -->
+
+<lufa>
+ <asf>
+ <select-by-config id="lufa.drivers.board" name="lufa.drivers.board.name" default="none" caption="LUFA Board Support">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Board hardware (LEDs, Buttons, etc.) drivers for the preconfigured LUFA boards. Note that only the boards
+ compatible with the currently selected device will be shown.
+
+ To disable all hardware drivers silently, use NONE. To supply customer drivers, use USER (see manual).
+ </info>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#none" caption="Board Support - None">
+ <device-support value="avr"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_NONE"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#user" caption="Board Support - User Supplied">
+ <device-support value="avr"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_USER"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#adafruit_u4" caption="Board Support - ADAFRUITU4">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_ADAFRUITU4"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u4"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_ADAFRUITU4"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/ADAFRUITU4/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/ADAFRUITU4/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#atavrusbrf01" caption="Board Support - ATAVRUSBRF01">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_ATAVRUSBRF01"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_ATAVRUSBRF01"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/ATAVRUSBRF01/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/ATAVRUSBRF01/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/ATAVRUSBRF01/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#benito" caption="Board Support - BENITO">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_BENITO"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb162"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_BENITO"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/BENITO/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/BENITO/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/BENITO/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#big_multio" caption="Board Support - BIGMULTIO">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_BIGMULTIO"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u4"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_BIGMULTIO"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/BIGMULTIO/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/BIGMULTIO/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#blackcat" caption="Board Support - BLACKCAT">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_BLACKCAT"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb162"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_BLACKCAT"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/BLACKCAT/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/BLACKCAT/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#bui" caption="Board Support - BUI">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_BUI"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb646"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_BUI"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUI/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUI/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#bumbleb" caption="Board Support - BUMBLEB">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_BUMBLEB"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb162"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_BUMBLEB"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUMBLEB/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUMBLEB/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUMBLEB/Joystick.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/BUMBLEB/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#culv3" caption="Board Support - CULV3">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_CULV3"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u4"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_CULV3"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/CULV3/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/CULV3/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/CULV3/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#duce" caption="Board Support - DUCE">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_DUCE"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u2"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_DUCE"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/DUCE/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/DUCE/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#evk527" caption="Board Support - EVK527">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_EVK527"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u4"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_EVK527"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.at45db321c"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.spi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.dataflash"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/Dataflash.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/Joystick.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/EVK527/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#jm_db_u2" caption="Board Support - JMDBU2">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_JMDBU2"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u2"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_JMDBU2"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/JMDBU2/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/JMDBU2/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/JMDBU2/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#leonardo" caption="Board Support - LEONARDO">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_LEONARDO"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u4"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_LEONARDO"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/LEONARDO/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/LEONARDO/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#maximus" caption="Board Support - MAXIMUS">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_MAXIMUS"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb162"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_MAXIMUS"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MAXIMUS/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MAXIMUS/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#micropendous_32u2" caption="Board Support - MICROPENDOUS_32U2">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_32U2"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u2"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_32U2"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/LEDs.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Buttons.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#micropendous_a" caption="Board Support - MICROPENDOUS_A">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_A"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_A"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Buttons.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#micropendous_1" caption="Board Support - MICROPENDOUS_1">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_1"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb162"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_1"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Buttons.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#micropendous_2" caption="Board Support - MICROPENDOUS_2">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_2"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u4"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_2"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Buttons.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#micropendous_3" caption="Board Support - MICROPENDOUS_3">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_3"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_3"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Buttons.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#micropendous_4" caption="Board Support - MICROPENDOUS_4">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_4"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_4"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Buttons.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#micropendous_dip" caption="Board Support - MICROPENDOUS_DIP">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_DIP"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_DIP"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Buttons.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#micropendous_rev1" caption="Board Support - MICROPENDOUS_REV1">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_REV1"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV1"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/LEDs.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Buttons.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#micropendous_rev2" caption="Board Support - MICROPENDOUS_REV2">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_MICROPENDOUS_REV2"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_MICROPENDOUS_REV2"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/LEDs.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROPENDOUS/Buttons.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#microsin_162" caption="Board Support - MICROSIN162">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_MICROSIN162"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega162"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_MICROSIN162"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROSIN162/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROSIN162/LEDs.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICROSIN162/Buttons.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#minimus" caption="Board Support - MINIMUS">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_MINIMUS"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u2"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_MINIMUS"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MINIMUS/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MINIMUS/LEDs.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MINIMUS/Buttons.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#multio" caption="Board Support - MULTIO">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_MULTIO"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb162"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_MULTIO"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MULTIO/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MULTIO/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#olimex_162" caption="Board Support - OLIMEX162">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_OLIMEX162"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb162"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_OLIMEX162"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX162/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX162/LEDs.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX162/Buttons.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#olimex_32u4" caption="Board Support - OLIMEX32U4">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_OLIMEX32U4"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u4"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_OLIMEX32U4"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX32U4/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX32U4/LEDs.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEX32U4/Buttons.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#olimex_isp_mkii" caption="Board Support - OLIMEXISPMK2">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_OLIMEXISPMK2"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb162"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_OLIMEXISPMK2"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXISPMK2/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXISPMK2/LEDs.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXISPMK2/Buttons.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#olimex_t32u4" caption="Board Support - OLIMEX_T32U4">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_OLIMEXT32U4"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u4"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_OLIMEXT32U4"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXT32U4/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXT32U4/LEDs.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/OLIMEXT32U4/Buttons.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#rzusbstick" caption="Board Support - RZUSBSTICK">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_RZUSBSTICK"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_RZUSBSTICK"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/RZUSBSTICK/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/RZUSBSTICK/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#sparkfun_8u2" caption="Board Support - SPARKFUN8U2">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_SPARKFUN8U2"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega8u2"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_SPARKFUN8U2"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/SPARKFUN8U2/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/SPARKFUN8U2/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#stk525" caption="Board Support - STK525">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_STK525"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <device-support value="at90usb1286"/>
+ <device-support value="at90usb647"/>
+ <device-support value="at90usb646"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_STK525"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.at45db321c"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.spi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.dataflash"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/Dataflash.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/Joystick.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK525/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#stk526" caption="Board Support - STK526">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_STK526"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb162"/>
+ <device-support value="at90usb82"/>
+ <device-support value="atmega32u2"/>
+ <device-support value="atmega16u2"/>
+ <device-support value="atmega8u2"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_STK526"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.at45db642d"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.spi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.dataflash"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/Dataflash.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/Joystick.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/STK526/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#teensy" caption="Board Support - TEENSY">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_TEENSY"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb162"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_TEENSY"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/TEENSY/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/TEENSY/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#teensy2" caption="Board Support - TEENSY2">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_TEENSY2"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb646"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_TEENSY2"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/TEENSY/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/TEENSY/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#tul" caption="Board Support - TUL">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_TUL"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u4"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_TUL"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/TUL/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/TUL/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/TUL/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#udip" caption="Board Support - UDIP">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_UDIP"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u2"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_UDIP"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/UDIP/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/UDIP/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/UDIP/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#uno" caption="Board Support - UNO">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_UNO"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega8u2"/>
+ <device-support value="atmega16u2"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_UNO"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/UNO/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/UNO/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#usb2ax" caption="Board Support - USB2AX">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_USB2AX"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u2"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_USB2AX"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USB2AX/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USB2AX/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USB2AX/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#usb2ax_v3" caption="Board Support - USB2AX_V3">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_USB2AX_V3"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u2"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_USB2AX_V3"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USB2AX/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USB2AX/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USB2AX/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#usb2ax_v3_1" caption="Board Support - USB2AX_V31">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_USB2AX_V31"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u2"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_USB2AX_V31"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USB2AX/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USB2AX/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USB2AX/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#usbfoo" caption="Board Support - USBFOO">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_USBFOO"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega162"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_USBFOO"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBFOO/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBFOO/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBFOO/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#usbkey" caption="Board Support - USBKEY">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_USBKEY"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_USBKEY"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.at45db642d"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.spi"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.dataflash"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/Dataflash.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/Joystick.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBKEY/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#usbtiny_mkii" caption="Board Support - USBTINYMKII">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_USBTINYMKII"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb162"/>
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_USBTINYMKII"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBTINYMKII/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBTINYMKII/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/USBTINYMKII/LEDs.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#xplain_rev1" caption="Board Support - XPLAIN (HW Rev 1)">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_XPLAIN_REV1"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.at45db642d"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.spi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.dataflash"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAIN/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAIN/Dataflash.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAIN/LEDs.h"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#xplain" caption="Board Support - XPLAIN (HW Rev 2+)">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_XPLAIN"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.at45db642d"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.spi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.dataflash"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAIN/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAIN/Dataflash.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/XPLAIN/LEDs.h"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_XPLAIN"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#a3bu_xplained" caption="Board Support - A3BU_XPLAINED">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_A3BU_XPLAINED"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega256a3bu"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.at45db642d"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart_spi"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.dataflash"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/Dataflash.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/XMEGA/A3BU_XPLAINED/LEDs.h"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_A3BU_XPLAINED"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#b1_xplained" caption="Board Support - B1_XPLAINED">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_B1_XPLAINED"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega128b1"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.at45db642d"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart_spi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.dataflash"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/Dataflash.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/XMEGA/B1_XPLAINED/LEDs.h"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_B1_XPLAINED"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#evk1100" caption="Board Support - EVK1100">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_EVK1100"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a0512"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1100/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1100/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1100/Joystick.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1100/LEDs.h"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_EVK1100"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#evk1101" caption="Board Support - EVK1101">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_EVK1101"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at32uc3b0256"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1101/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1101/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1101/Joystick.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1101/LEDs.h"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_EVK1101"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#evk1104" caption="Board Support - EVK1104">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_EVK1104"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a3256"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1104/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1104/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/UC3/EVK1104/LEDs.h"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_EVK1104"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#uc3a3_xplained" caption="Board Support - UC3A3_XPLAINED">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_UC3_A3_XPLAINED"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at32uc3a3256"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/UC3/UC3A3_XPLAINED/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/UC3/UC3A3_XPLAINED/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/UC3/UC3A3_XPLAINED/LEDs.h"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_UC3A3_XPLAINED"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#stange_isp" caption="Board Support - STANGE_ISP">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_STANGE_ISP"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb162"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/STANGE_ISP/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/STANGE_ISP/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/STANGE_ISP/LEDs.h"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_STANGE_ISP"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#c3_xplained" caption="Board Support - C3_XPLAINED">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_C3_XPLAINED"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atxmega384c3"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/XMEGA/C3_XPLAINED/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/XMEGA/C3_XPLAINED/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/XMEGA/C3_XPLAINED/LEDs.h"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_C3_XPLAINED"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#u2s" caption="Board Support - U2S">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_U2S"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u2"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/U2S/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/U2S/Buttons.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/U2S/LEDs.h"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_U2S"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#yun" caption="Board Support - YUN">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_YUN"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u4"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/YUN/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/YUN/LEDs.h"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_YUN"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.board#micro" caption="Board Support - MICRO">
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_BoardInfo_MICRO"/>
+
+ <device-support value="atmega32u4"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICRO/Board.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Board/AVR8/MICRO/LEDs.h"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="BOARD" value="BOARD_MICRO"/>
+ </module>
+ </select-by-config>
+ </asf>
+</lufa>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_misc.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_misc.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ee72f33db0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_misc.xml @@ -0,0 +1,57 @@ +<!--
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+-->
+
+<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file -->
+
+<lufa>
+ <asf>
+ <module type="component" id="lufa.drivers.misc.at45db321c" caption="LUFA AT45DB321C Dataflash Commands">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_AT45DB321C"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/Misc/AT45DB321C.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="component" id="lufa.drivers.misc.at45db642d" caption="LUFA AT45DB642D Dataflash Commands">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_AT45DB321C"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/Misc/AT45DB642D.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.misc.ringbuffer" caption="LUFA Ring Buffer">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_RingBuff"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/Misc/RingBuffer.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi" caption="LUFA ANSI Terminal Commands">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_Terminal"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h"/>
+ </module>
+ </asf>
+</lufa>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_peripheral.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_peripheral.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b4eb8747a2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_peripheral.xml @@ -0,0 +1,198 @@ +<!--
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+-->
+
+<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file -->
+
+<lufa>
+ <asf>
+ <select-by-device id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart" caption="LUFA USART Driver">
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart#avr8" caption="LUFA USART Driver - AVR8">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_Serial"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/Serial_AVR8.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/Serial_AVR8.h"/>
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart#xmega" caption="LUFA USART Driver - AVR8">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_Serial"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/Serial_XMEGA.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/Serial_XMEGA.h"/>
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart#uc3" caption="LUFA USART Driver - UC3">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_Serial"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+ </module>
+ </select-by-device>
+
+ <select-by-device id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.spi" caption="LUFA SPI Driver">
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.spi#avr8" caption="LUFA SPI Driver - AVR8">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_SPI"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/SPI_AVR8.h"/>
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/Peripheral/SPI.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.spi#xmega" caption="LUFA SPI Driver - XMEGA">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_SPI"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/SPI_XMEGA.h"/>
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/Peripheral/SPI.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.spi#uc3" caption="LUFA SPI Driver - UC3">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_SPI"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+ </module>
+ </select-by-device>
+
+ <select-by-device id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart_spi" caption="LUFA USART SPI Driver">
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart_spi#avr8" caption="LUFA USART SPI Driver - AVR8">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_SerialSPI"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/SerialSPI_AVR8.h"/>
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/Peripheral/SerialSPI.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart_spi#xmega" caption="LUFA USART SPI Driver - XMEGA">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_SerialSPI"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/SerialSPI_XMEGA.h"/>
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/Peripheral/SerialSPI.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart_spi#uc3" caption="LUFA USART SPI Driver - UC3">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_SerialSPI"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+ </module>
+ </select-by-device>
+
+ <select-by-device id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.twi" caption="LUFA TWI Master Driver">
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.twi#avr8" caption="LUFA TWI Master Driver - AVR8">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_TWI"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/TWI_AVR8.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/TWI_AVR8.h"/>
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/Peripheral/TWI.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.twi#xmega" caption="LUFA TWI Master Driver - XMEGA">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_TWI"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/TWI_XMEGA.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Peripheral/XMEGA/TWI_XMEGA.h"/>
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/Peripheral/TWI.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.twi#uc3" caption="LUFA TWI Master Driver - UC3">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_TWI"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+ </module>
+ </select-by-device>
+
+ <select-by-device id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.adc" caption="LUFA ADC Driver">
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.adc#avr8" caption="LUFA ADC Driver - AVR8">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_ADC"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/Peripheral/AVR8/ADC_AVR8.h"/>
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/Peripheral/ADC.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.adc#xmega" caption="LUFA ADC Driver - XMEGA">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_ADC"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.peripheral.adc#uc3" caption="LUFA ADC Driver - UC3">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_ADC"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+ </module>
+ </select-by-device>
+ </asf>
+</lufa>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f07aad672b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb.xml @@ -0,0 +1,32 @@ +<!--
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+-->
+
+<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file -->
+
+<lufa>
+ <asf>
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.usb" caption="LUFA USB Driver">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USB"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="USE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER" value=""/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="CodeTemplates"/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Drivers/USB/USB.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb.class"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb.core"/>
+ </module>
+ </asf>
+</lufa>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..123d60643b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class.xml @@ -0,0 +1,32 @@ +<!--
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+-->
+
+<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file -->
+
+<lufa>
+ <asf>
+ <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class" caption="LUFA USB Class Drivers">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassDrivers"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb.class.android"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb.class.audio"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb.class.cdc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb.class.hid"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb.class.ms"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb.class.midi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb.class.printer"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb.class.rndis"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb.class.si"/>
+ </module>
+ </asf>
+</lufa>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_android.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_android.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3ec06ed6cb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_android.xml @@ -0,0 +1,54 @@ +<!-- + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +--> + +<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file --> + +<lufa> + <asf> + <select-by-config id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.android" name="lufa.drivers.usb.class.android.mode" default="host" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Android Accessory"> + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassAOA"/> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.android#host" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Android Accessory (Host)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Host mode implementation of the Android Open Accessory USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassAOA"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/AndroidAccessoryClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/AndroidAccessoryClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AndroidAccessoryClassHost.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AndroidAccessoryClassHost.c"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.android#definitions_only" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Android Accessory (Definitions Only)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions only (no implementations) of the Android Open Accessory USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassAOA"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/AndroidAccessoryClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/AndroidAccessoryClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AndroidAccessoryClassHost.h"/> + </module> + </select-by-config> + </asf> +</lufa> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_audio.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_audio.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d93925dab1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_audio.xml @@ -0,0 +1,109 @@ +<!-- + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +--> + +<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file --> + +<!-- + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +--> + +<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file --> + +<lufa> + <asf> + <select-by-config id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.audio" name="lufa.drivers.usb.class.audio.mode" default="host_device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Audio 1.0"> + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassAudio"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.audio#host_device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Audio 1.0 (Host/Device)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Host/Device mode implementations of the Audio 1.0 USB class. + </info> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassAudio"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/AudioClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/AudioClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/AudioClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/AudioClassDevice.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AudioClassHost.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AudioClassHost.c"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.audio#host" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Audio 1.0 (Host)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Host mode implementation of the Audio 1.0 USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassAudio"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/AudioClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/AudioClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/AudioClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AudioClassHost.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AudioClassHost.c"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.audio#device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Audio 1.0 (Device)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Device mode implementation of the Audio 1.0 USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassAudio"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/AudioClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/AudioClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/AudioClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/AudioClassDevice.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AudioClassHost.h"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.audio#definitions_only" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Audio 1.0 (Definitions Only)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions only (no implementations) of the Audio 1.0 USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassAudio"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/AudioClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/AudioClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/AudioClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/AudioClassHost.h"/> + </module> + </select-by-config> + </asf> +</lufa> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_cdc.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_cdc.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6c4f678d3e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_cdc.xml @@ -0,0 +1,99 @@ +<!-- + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +--> + +<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file --> + +<lufa> + <asf> + <select-by-config id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.cdc" name="lufa.drivers.usb.class.cdc.mode" default="host_device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - CDC"> + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassCDC"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.cdc#host_device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - CDC (Host/Device)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Host/Device mode implementations of the CDC USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassCDC"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/CDCClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/CDCClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/CDCClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/CDCClassDevice.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/CDCClassHost.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/CDCClassHost.c"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.cdc#host" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - CDC (Host)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Host mode implementation of the CDC USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassCDC"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/CDCClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/CDCClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/CDCClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/CDCClassHost.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/CDCClassHost.c"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.cdc#device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - CDC (Device)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Device mode implementation of the CDC USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassCDC"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/CDCClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/CDCClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/CDCClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/CDCClassDevice.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/CDCClassHost.h"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.cdc#definitions_only" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - CDC (Definitions Only)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions only (no implementations) of the CDC USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassCDC"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/CDCClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/CDCClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/CDCClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/CDCClassHost.h"/> + </module> + </select-by-config> + </asf> +</lufa> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_hid.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_hid.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d9e70a97c4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_hid.xml @@ -0,0 +1,99 @@ +<!-- + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +--> + +<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file --> + +<lufa> + <asf> + <select-by-config id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.hid" name="lufa.drivers.usb.class.hid.mode" default="host_device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - HID"> + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassHID"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.hid#host_device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - HID (Host/Device)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Host/Device mode implementations of the HID USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassHID"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/HIDClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/HIDClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/HIDClassDevice.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/HIDClassHost.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/HIDClassHost.c"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.hid#host" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - HID (Host)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Host mode implementation of the HID USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassHID"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/HIDClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/HIDClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/HIDClassHost.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/HIDClassHost.c"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.hid#device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - HID (Device)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Device mode implementation of the HID USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassHID"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/HIDClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/HIDClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/HIDClassDevice.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/HIDClassHost.h"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.hid#definitions_only" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - HID (Definitions Only)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions only (no implementations) of the HID USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassHID"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/HIDClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/HIDClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/HIDClassHost.h"/> + </module> + </select-by-config> + </asf> +</lufa> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_midi.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_midi.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c127ae2cea --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_midi.xml @@ -0,0 +1,99 @@ +<!-- + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +--> + +<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file --> + +<lufa> + <asf> + <select-by-config id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.midi" name="lufa.drivers.usb.class.midi.mode" default="host_device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - MIDI"> + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassMIDI"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.midi#host_device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - MIDI (Host/Device)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Host/Device mode implementations of the MIDI USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassMIDI"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/MIDIClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/MIDIClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MIDIClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MIDIClassDevice.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MIDIClassHost.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MIDIClassHost.c"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.midi#host" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - MIDI (Host)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Host mode implementation of the MIDI USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassMIDI"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/MIDIClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/MIDIClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MIDIClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MIDIClassHost.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MIDIClassHost.c"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.midi#device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - MIDI (Device)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Device mode implementation of the MIDI USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassMIDI"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/MIDIClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/MIDIClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MIDIClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MIDIClassDevice.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MIDIClassHost.h"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.midi#definitions_only" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - MIDI (Definitions Only)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions only (no implementations) of the MIDI USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassMIDI"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/MIDIClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/MIDIClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MIDIClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MIDIClassHost.h"/> + </module> + </select-by-config> + </asf> +</lufa> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_ms.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_ms.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1be340310d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_ms.xml @@ -0,0 +1,99 @@ +<!-- + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +--> + +<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file --> + +<lufa> + <asf> + <select-by-config id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.ms" name="lufa.drivers.usb.class.ms.mode" default="host_device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Mass Storage"> + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassMS"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.ms#host_device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Mass Storage (Host/Device)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Host/Device mode implementations of the Mass Storage USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassMS"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/MassStorageClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/MassStorageClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MassStorageClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MassStorageClassDevice.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MassStorageClassHost.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MassStorageClassHost.c"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.ms#host" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Mass Storage (Host)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Host mode implementation of the Mass Storage USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassMS"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/MassStorageClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/MassStorageClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MassStorageClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MassStorageClassHost.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MassStorageClassHost.c"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.ms#device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Mass Storage (Device)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Device mode implementation of the Mass Storage USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassMS"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/MassStorageClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/MassStorageClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MassStorageClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MassStorageClassDevice.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MassStorageClassHost.h"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.ms#definitions_only" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Mass Storage (Definitions Only)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions only (no implementations) of the Mass Storage USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassMS"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/MassStorageClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/MassStorageClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/MassStorageClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/MassStorageClassHost.h"/> + </module> + </select-by-config> + </asf> +</lufa> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_printer.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_printer.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3b1fbe60ad --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_printer.xml @@ -0,0 +1,99 @@ +<!-- + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +--> + +<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file --> + +<lufa> + <asf> + <select-by-config id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.printer" name="lufa.drivers.usb.class.printer.mode" default="host_device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Printer"> + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassPrinter"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.printer#host_device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Printer (Host/Device)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Host/Device mode implementations of the Printer USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassPrinter"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/PrinterClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/PrinterClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/PrinterClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/PrinterClassDevice.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/PrinterClassHost.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/PrinterClassHost.c"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.printer#host" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Printer (Host)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Host mode implementation of the Printer USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassPrinter"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/PrinterClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/PrinterClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/PrinterClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/PrinterClassHost.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/PrinterClassHost.c"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.printer#device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Printer (Device)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Device mode implementation of the Printer USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassPrinter"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/PrinterClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/PrinterClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/PrinterClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/PrinterClassDevice.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/PrinterClassHost.h"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.printer#definitions_only" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Printer (Definitions Only)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions only (no implementations) of the Printer USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassPrinter"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/PrinterClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/PrinterClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/PrinterClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/PrinterClassHost.h"/> + </module> + </select-by-config> + </asf> +</lufa> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_rndis.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_rndis.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..09e86fbf0e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_rndis.xml @@ -0,0 +1,99 @@ +<!-- + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +--> + +<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file --> + +<lufa> + <asf> + <select-by-config id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.rndis" name="lufa.drivers.usb.class.rndis.mode" default="host_device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - RNDIS Ethernet"> + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassRNDIS"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.rndis#host_device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - RNDIS Ethernet (Host/Device)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Host/Device mode implementations of the RNDIS Ethernet USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassRNDIS"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/RNDISClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/RNDISClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/RNDISClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/RNDISClassDevice.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/RNDISClassHost.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/RNDISClassHost.c"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.rndis#host" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - RNDIS Ethernet (Host)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Host mode implementation of the RNDIS Ethernet USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassRNDIS"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/RNDISClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/RNDISClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/RNDISClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/RNDISClassHost.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/RNDISClassHost.c"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.rndis#device" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - RNDIS Ethernet (Device)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Device mode implementation of the RNDIS Ethernet USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassRNDIS"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/RNDISClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/RNDISClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/RNDISClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/RNDISClassDevice.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/RNDISClassHost.h"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.rndis#definitions_only" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - RNDIS Ethernet (Definitions Only)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions only (no implementations) of the RNDIS Ethernet USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassRNDIS"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/RNDISClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/RNDISClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Device/RNDISClassDevice.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/RNDISClassHost.h"/> + </module> + </select-by-config> + </asf> +</lufa> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_si.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_si.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..eb0786ceae --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_class_si.xml @@ -0,0 +1,56 @@ +<!-- + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +--> + +<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file --> + +<lufa> + <asf> + <select-by-config id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.si" name="lufa.drivers.usb.class.si.mode" default="host" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Still Image"> + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassSI"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.si#host" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Still Image (Host)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions and Host mode implementation of the Still Image USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassSI"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/StillImageClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/StillImageClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/StillImageClassHost.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/StillImageClassHost.c"/> + </module> + + <module type="service" id="lufa.drivers.usb.class.si#definitions_only" caption="LUFA USB Class Driver - Still Image (Definitions Only)"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Common definitions only (no implementations) of the Still Image USB class. + </info> + + <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBClassSI"/> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/StillImageClass.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/StillImageClassCommon.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Host/StillImageClassHost.h"/> + </module> + </select-by-config> + </asf> +</lufa> diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_core.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_core.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..095bcd2798 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_core.xml @@ -0,0 +1,85 @@ +<!--
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+-->
+
+<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file -->
+
+<lufa>
+ <asf>
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.usb.core.common" caption="LUFA USB Core Driver - Common">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBManagement"/>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/Device.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/Endpoint.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/Host.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/Pipe.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/OTG.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/USBController.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/USBInterrupt.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/EndpointStream.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/PipeStream.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/ConfigDescriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/ConfigDescriptors.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/DeviceStandardReq.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/DeviceStandardReq.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/Events.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/Events.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/HostStandardReq.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/HostStandardReq.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/USBTask.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/USBTask.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/USBMode.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/StdDescriptors.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/StdRequestType.h"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDParser.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDParser.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Class/Common/HIDReportData.h"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <select-by-device id="lufa.drivers.usb.core" caption="LUFA USB Core Driver">
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.usb.core#avr8" caption="LUFA USB Core Driver - AVR8">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBManagement_AVR8"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb.core.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb.core.avr8"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.usb.core#xmega" caption="LUFA USB Core Driver - XMEGA">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBManagement_XMEGA"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb.core.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb.core.xmega"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.usb.core#uc3" caption="LUFA USB Core Driver - UC3">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBManagement_UC3"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb.core.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb.core.uc3"/>
+ </module>
+ </select-by-device>
+ </asf>
+</lufa>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_core_avr8.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_core_avr8.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b2792cb2f7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_core_avr8.xml @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +<!--
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+-->
+
+<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file -->
+
+<lufa>
+ <asf>
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.usb.core.avr8" caption="LUFA USB Core Driver for AVR8">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBManagement_AVR8"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Device_AVR8.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Device_AVR8.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Endpoint_AVR8.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Endpoint_AVR8.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Host_AVR8.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Host_AVR8.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Pipe_AVR8.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/Pipe_AVR8.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/OTG_AVR8.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/USBController_AVR8.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/USBController_AVR8.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/USBInterrupt_AVR8.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/USBInterrupt_AVR8.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/EndpointStream_AVR8.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/EndpointStream_AVR8.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/PipeStream_AVR8.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/AVR8/PipeStream_AVR8.h"/>
+ </module>
+ </asf>
+</lufa>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_core_uc3.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_core_uc3.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d815fca449 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_core_uc3.xml @@ -0,0 +1,42 @@ +<!--
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+-->
+
+<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file -->
+
+<lufa>
+ <asf>
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.usb.core.uc3" caption="LUFA USB Core Driver for UC3">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBManagement_UC3"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Template/Template_Pipe_RW.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Device_UC3.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Device_UC3.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Endpoint_UC3.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Endpoint_UC3.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Host_UC3.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Host_UC3.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Pipe_UC3.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/Pipe_UC3.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/USBController_UC3.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/USBController_UC3.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/USBInterrupt_UC3.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/USBInterrupt_UC3.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/EndpointStream_UC3.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/EndpointStream_UC3.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/PipeStream_UC3.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/UC3/PipeStream_UC3.h"/>
+ </module>
+ </asf>
+</lufa>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_core_xmega.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_core_xmega.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..364a0f3ed5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_drivers_usb_core_xmega.xml @@ -0,0 +1,36 @@ +<!--
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+-->
+
+<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file -->
+
+<lufa>
+ <asf>
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.drivers.usb.core.xmega" caption="LUFA USB Core Driver for XMEGA">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_USBManagement_XMEGA"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_R.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Template/Template_Endpoint_Control_W.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Template/Template_Endpoint_RW.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Device_XMEGA.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Device_XMEGA.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Endpoint_XMEGA.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Endpoint_XMEGA.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/Pipe_XMEGA.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/USBController_XMEGA.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/USBController_XMEGA.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/USBInterrupt_XMEGA.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/USBInterrupt_XMEGA.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/EndpointStream_XMEGA.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Drivers/USB/Core/XMEGA/EndpointStream_XMEGA.h"/>
+ </module>
+ </asf>
+</lufa>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_platform.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_platform.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e20b718fb0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_platform.xml @@ -0,0 +1,60 @@ +<!--
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+-->
+
+<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file -->
+
+<lufa>
+ <asf>
+ <select-by-device id="lufa.platform" caption="LUFA Platform Specific Support">
+ <module type="service" id="lufa.platform#avr8" caption="LUFA Platform Specific Support - AVR8">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="ARCH" value="ARCH_AVR8"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_PlatformDrivers"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Platform/Platform.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="service" id="lufa.platform#xmega" caption="LUFA Platform Specific Support - XMEGA">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="ARCH" value="ARCH_XMEGA"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_PlatformDrivers"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Platform/Platform.h"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" value="Platform/XMEGA/XMEGAExperimentalInfo.txt" subtype="license"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.platform.xmega"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="service" id="lufa.platform#uc3" caption="LUFA Platform Specific Support - UC3">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="ARCH" value="ARCH_UC3"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_PlatformDrivers"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value=".."/>
+ <build type="header-file" subtype="api" value="Platform/Platform.h"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" value="Platform/UC3/UC3ExperimentalInfo.txt" subtype="license"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.platform.uc3"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ </module>
+ </select-by-device>
+ </asf>
+</lufa>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_platform_uc3.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_platform_uc3.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8c26d2304f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_platform_uc3.xml @@ -0,0 +1,26 @@ +<!--
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+-->
+
+<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file -->
+
+<lufa>
+ <asf>
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.platform.uc3" caption="LUFA UC3 Platform Drivers">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_PlatformDrivers_UC3"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Platform/UC3/ClockManagement.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Platform/UC3/InterruptManagement.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Platform/UC3/InterruptManagement.c"/>
+ <build type="asm-source" value="Platform/UC3/Exception.S"/>
+ </module>
+ </asf>
+</lufa>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_platform_xmega.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_platform_xmega.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..299c859662 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_platform_xmega.xml @@ -0,0 +1,23 @@ +<!--
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+-->
+
+<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file -->
+
+<lufa>
+ <asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <module type="driver" id="lufa.platform.xmega" caption="LUFA XMEGA Platform Drivers">
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+
+ <build type="doxygen-entry-point" value="Group_PlatformDrivers_XMEGA"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Platform/XMEGA/ClockManagement.h"/>
+ </module>
+ </asf>
+</lufa>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_toolchain.xml b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_toolchain.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..66b416e28b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/lufa_toolchain.xml @@ -0,0 +1,45 @@ +<!--
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.lufa-lib.org
+-->
+
+<!-- Atmel Studio framework integration file -->
+
+<lufa>
+ <asf>
+ <select-by-device id="common.utils.toolchain_config" caption="Toolchain configuration defaults">
+ <module type="build-specific" id="common.utils.toolchain_config#avr" caption="Toolchain configuration defaults for 8-bit AVR">
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+ <device-support value="avr"/>
+
+ <toolchain-config name="avrgcc.compiler.general.ChangeDefaultBitFieldUnsigned" value="True" toolchain="avrgcc"/>
+ <toolchain-config name="avrgcc.compiler.general.ChangeDefaultCharTypeUnsigned" value="True" toolchain="avrgcc"/>
+ <toolchain-config name="avrgcc.compiler.optimization.OtherFlags" value="-fdata-sections" toolchain="avrgcc"/>
+ <toolchain-config name="avrgcc.compiler.optimization.PrepareFunctionsForGarbageCollection" value="True" toolchain="avrgcc"/>
+ <toolchain-config name="avrgcc.compiler.warnings.AllWarnings" value="True" toolchain="avrgcc"/>
+ <toolchain-config name="avrgcc.compiler.miscellaneous.OtherFlags" value="-mrelax -std=gnu99 -fno-strict-aliasing -fno-jump-tables" toolchain="avrgcc"/>
+ <toolchain-config name="avrgcc.linker.optimization.GarbageCollectUnusedSections" value="True" toolchain="avrgcc"/>
+ <toolchain-config name="avrgcc.linker.optimization.RelaxBranches" value="True" toolchain="avrgcc"/>
+ <toolchain-config name="avrgcc.linker.miscellaneous.LinkerFlags" value="-Wl,--relax" toolchain="avrgcc"/>
+ </module>
+ </select-by-device>
+
+ <module type="build-specific" id="common.utils.toolchain_config#uc3" caption="Toolchain configuration defaults for 32-bit AVR">
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+ <device-support value="uc3"/>
+
+ <toolchain-config name="avrgcc.compiler.general.ChangeDefaultBitFieldUnsigned" value="True" toolchain="avr32gcc"/>
+ <toolchain-config name="avrgcc.compiler.general.ChangeDefaultCharTypeUnsigned" value="True" toolchain="avr32gcc"/>
+ <toolchain-config name="avr32gcc.compiler.optimization.OtherFlags" value="-fdata-sections" toolchain="avr32gcc"/>
+ <toolchain-config name="avr32gcc.compiler.optimization.PrepareFunctionsForGarbageCollection" value="True" toolchain="avr32gcc"/>
+ <toolchain-config name="avr32gcc.compiler.warnings.AllWarnings" value="True" toolchain="avr32gcc"/>
+ <toolchain-config name="avr32gcc.compiler.miscellaneous.OtherFlags" value="-mrelax -std=gnu99 -fno-strict-aliasing -mno-cond-exec-before-reload" toolchain="avr32gcc"/>
+ <toolchain-config name="avr32gcc.linker.optimization.GarbageCollectUnusedSections" value="True" toolchain="avr32gcc"/>
+ <toolchain-config name="avr32gcc.linker.optimization.RelaxBranches" value="True" toolchain="avr32gcc"/>
+ <toolchain-config name="avr32gcc.linker.miscellaneous.LinkerFlags" value="-Wl,--relax" toolchain="avr32gcc"/>
+ </module>
+ </asf>
+</lufa>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/makefile b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..30483e9cb5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/StudioIntegration/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,142 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# --------------------------------------- +# Makefile for the LUFA Atmel Studio Integration. +# --------------------------------------- + +LUFA_ROOT := .. +LUFA_VERSION_NUM := $(shell grep -e "\#define *LUFA_VERSION_STRING " $(LUFA_ROOT)/Version.h | cut -d'"' -f2) +LUFA_VERSION_TYPE := $(shell grep -e "\#define *LUFA_VERSION_RELEASE_TYPE " $(LUFA_ROOT)/Version.h) + +ifneq ($(findstring LUFA_VERSION_RELEASE_TYPE_DEVELOPMENT, $(LUFA_VERSION_TYPE)),LUFA_VERSION_RELEASE_TYPE_DEVELOPMENT) + EXT_VERSION_NUM := $(shell date +"%y.%m.%d").$(LUFA_VERSION_NUM) + EXT_VSIX_NAME := LUFA-RELEASE-$(LUFA_VERSION_NUM).vsix +else + EXT_VERSION_NUM := 0.$(shell date +"%y%m%d.%H%M%S") + EXT_VSIX_NAME := LUFA-TESTING-$(shell date +"%y.%m.%d-%H.%M.%S").vsix + + $(warning Development mode set - assuming a test version should be created.) +endif + +DOXYGEN_TAG_FILE_XML := $(LUFA_ROOT)/Documentation/lufa_doc_tags.xml +DOXYGEN_COMBINED_XML := $(LUFA_ROOT)/Documentation/xml/lufa_doc.xml +TEMP_MANIFEST_XML := manifest.xml +EXTENSION_OUTPUT_XML := $(LUFA_ROOT)/../extension.xml +MODULE_OUTPUT_XML := $(LUFA_ROOT)/asf.xml +MSHELP_OUTPUT_XML := $(LUFA_ROOT)/../lufa_help_$(subst .,_,$(EXT_VERSION_NUM)).mshc +XML_FILES := $(filter-out $(TEMP_MANIFEST_FILE), $(shell ls *.xml)) +VSIX_ASSETS := $(LUFA_ROOT)/DoxygenPages/Images/LUFA_thumb.png \ + $(LUFA_ROOT)/DoxygenPages/Images/LUFA.png \ + $(LUFA_ROOT)/License.txt \ + VSIX/"[Content_Types].xml" \ + VSIX/LUFA.dll \ + VSIX/LUFA.pkgdef +VSIX_GEN_PARAMS := --stringparam extension-version "$(EXT_VERSION_NUM)" \ + --stringparam lufa-version "$(LUFA_VERSION_NUM)" \ + --stringparam help-package-filename "$(notdir $(MSHELP_OUTPUT_XML))" +MSHELP_GEN_PARAMS := --stringparam generate.toc "book toc" \ + --stringparam chunk.quietly "1" \ + --stringparam chunk.section.depth "3" \ + --stringparam chunk.first.sections "1" \ + --stringparam chapter.autolabel "0" \ + --stringparam root.filename "LUFA" \ + --stringparam html.stylesheet "lufa_studio_help_styling.css" + +all: clear_project_dirs generate_xml check_filenames generate_vsix + +clear_project_dirs: + @make -s -C $(LUFA_ROOT)/.. clean + +clean: + @rm -f $(TEMP_MANIFEST_XML) $(MODULE_OUTPUT_XML) $(EXTENSION_OUTPUT_XML) $(DOXYGEN_TAG_FILE_XML) $(DOXYGEN_COMBINED_XML) $(MSHELP_OUTPUT_XML) + @rm -rf mshelp + @cd $(LUFA_ROOT)/.. && rm -f contents.zip exampleProjects.xml content.xml.cache extension.vsixmanifest asf-manifest.xml extension.xml helpcontentsetup.msha $(notdir $(VSIX_ASSETS)) *.vsix *.mshc + +$(DOXYGEN_TAG_FILE_XML): + @make -C ../ doxygen DOXYGEN_OVERRIDE_PARAMS="GENERATE_TAGFILE=Documentation/lufa_doc_tags.xml GENERATE_HTML=no GENERATE_XML=yes" + +$(DOXYGEN_COMBINED_XML): $(DOXYGEN_TAG_FILE_XML) + @xsltproc $(dir $@)/combine.xslt $(dir $@)/index.xml > $(DOXYGEN_COMBINED_XML) + +$(TEMP_MANIFEST_XML): $(DOXYGEN_TAG_FILE_XML) $(DOXYGEN_COMBINED_XML) + @echo Generating temporary module manifest XML... + + @printf "<lufa-manifest version=\"%s\" tagfile=\"%s\" docfile=\"%s\">\n" $(LUFA_VERSION_NUM) $(DOXYGEN_TAG_FILE_XML) $(DOXYGEN_COMBINED_XML) > $@ + @for i in $(XML_FILES); do \ + printf "\t<xml-source filename=\"%s\"/>\n" $$i >> $@; \ + done; + @echo '</lufa-manifest>' >> $@ + +$(MODULE_OUTPUT_XML): $(TEMP_MANIFEST_XML) + @echo Generating library core XDK module manifest file... + @xsltproc XDK/lufa_module_transform.xslt $< | xsltproc XDK/lufa_indent_transform.xslt - > $(MODULE_OUTPUT_XML) + +$(EXTENSION_OUTPUT_XML): $(TEMP_MANIFEST_XML) + @echo Generating library XDK extension manifest file... + @xsltproc XDK/lufa_extension_transform.xslt $< | xsltproc XDK/lufa_indent_transform.xslt - > $(EXTENSION_OUTPUT_XML) + +$(MSHELP_OUTPUT_XML): $(DOXYGEN_COMBINED_XML) + @echo Converting Doxygen XML to DocBook... + @-mkdir mshelp 2> /dev/null + @xsltproc HV1/lufa_docbook_transform.xslt $(DOXYGEN_COMBINED_XML) > mshelp/lufa_docbook.xml + + @echo Converting DocBook XML to Microsoft Help 1.0... + @cd mshelp && xsltproc $(MSHELP_GEN_PARAMS) ../HV1/lufa_hv1_transform.xslt lufa_docbook.xml + + @echo Copying help assets... + @cp HV1/lufa_studio_help_styling.css mshelp + @-mkdir mshelp/images 2> /dev/null + @cp `find $(LUFA_ROOT)/DoxygenPages/Images -type f` mshelp/images + + @echo Archiving help content... + @cd mshelp && zip ../$(MSHELP_OUTPUT_XML) -q -0 -r *.html *.css images + + @echo Generating HV1 manifest... + @xsltproc $(VSIX_GEN_PARAMS) HV1/lufa_helpcontentsetup_transform.xslt HV1/helpcontentsetup.msha > $(LUFA_ROOT)/../helpcontentsetup.msha + +generate_help: $(MSHELP_OUTPUT_XML) + +generate_xml: $(EXTENSION_OUTPUT_XML) $(MODULE_OUTPUT_XML) + +generate_vsix: $(EXTENSION_OUTPUT_XML) $(MODULE_OUTPUT_XML) $(MSHELP_OUTPUT_XML) + @echo Generating XDK cache files... + @rm -f $(LUFA_ROOT)/../content.xml.cache + @rm -f $(LUFA_ROOT)/../ExampleProjects.xml + @python VSIX/generate_caches.py $(LUFA_ROOT)/../ + + @echo Archiving XDK content... + @rm -f contents.zip + @cd $(LUFA_ROOT)/../ && zip contents.zip -q -0 -r --exclude=*Documentation* --exclude=*StudioIntegration* LUFA Bootloaders Demos Projects README.txt + + @echo Creating VSIX dependencies... + @cp $(VSIX_ASSETS) $(LUFA_ROOT)/.. + @xsltproc $(VSIX_GEN_PARAMS) VSIX/lufa_vsmanifest_transform.xslt VSIX/extension.vsixmanifest > $(LUFA_ROOT)/../extension.vsixmanifest + @xsltproc $(VSIX_GEN_PARAMS) VSIX/lufa_asfmanifest_transform.xslt VSIX/asf-manifest.xml > $(LUFA_ROOT)/../asf-manifest.xml + + @echo Generating Atmel Studio VSIX file... + cd $(LUFA_ROOT)/../ && zip $(EXT_VSIX_NAME) -q -9 contents.zip exampleProjects.xml content.xml.cache extension.vsixmanifest asf-manifest.xml extension.xml helpcontentsetup.msha $(notdir $(MSHELP_OUTPUT_XML)) $(notdir $(VSIX_ASSETS)) + + @echo "Atmel Studio VSIX extension file generated." + +check_filenames: $(MODULE_OUTPUT_XML) + @echo Verifying referenced filenames of XDK modules... + @for f in `find $(LUFA_ROOT)/../ -name "asf.xml"`; do \ + echo "Checking $$f..."; \ + asf_file_dir=`dirname $$f`; \ + xsltproc XDK/lufa_filelist_transform.xslt $$f | sed -e "/^$$/d" | while read -r i; do \ + if ( ( ! test -f "$$asf_file_dir/$$i" ) && ( ! test -d "$$asf_file_dir/$$i" ) ); then \ + echo "Source file \"$$i\" referenced in $$f does not exist!"; \ + exit 1; \ + fi; \ + done || exit 1; \ + done; + +check_database: + python ProjectGenerator/project_generator.py -b $(LUFA_ROOT)/../ --main-ext-uuid=0e160d5c-e331-48d9-850b-e0387912171b CHECK + +.PHONY: all clean generate_help generate_xml generate_vsix check_filenames check_database diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/Version.h b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Version.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..03cb08406a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/Version.h @@ -0,0 +1,67 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * \brief LUFA library version constants. + * + * Version constants for informational purposes and version-specific macro creation. This header file contains the + * current LUFA version number in several forms, for use in the user-application (for example, for printing out + * whilst debugging, or for testing for version compatibility). + */ + +#ifndef __LUFA_VERSION_H__ +#define __LUFA_VERSION_H__ + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** \name LUFA Release Type Constants */ + //@{ + /** Constant for \ref LUFA_VERSION_RELEASE_TYPE indicating a development release. */ + #define LUFA_VERSION_RELEASE_TYPE_DEVELOPMENT 0 + + /** Constant for \ref LUFA_VERSION_RELEASE_TYPE indicating a beta release. */ + #define LUFA_VERSION_RELEASE_TYPE_BETA 1 + + /** Constant for \ref LUFA_VERSION_RELEASE_TYPE indicating a full official release. */ + #define LUFA_VERSION_RELEASE_TYPE_FULL 2 + //@} + + /** Indicates the version number of the library, as an integer. \note This value is only updates in non-development releases. */ + #define LUFA_VERSION_INTEGER 0x170418 + + /** Indicates the version number of the library, as a string. \note This value is only updates in non-development releases. */ + #define LUFA_VERSION_STRING "170418" + + /** Indicates the release type of the library. */ + #define LUFA_VERSION_RELEASE_TYPE LUFA_VERSION_RELEASE_TYPE_FULL + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/LUFA/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..90b8ca2f76 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2400 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = 000000 + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = ./DoxygenPages/Images/LUFA_thumb.png + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = NO + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = NO + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = NO + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = YES + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = YES + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = YES + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 1 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ \ + StudioIntegration/ \ + Build/ \ + License.txt + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = _* \ + __* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = ./ \ + CodeTemplates/ + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = ./ + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = ./DoxygenPages/Style/Footer.htm + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = ./DoxygenPages/Style/Style.css + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 120 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = com.lufa-lib.library.documentation + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = DeanCamera + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = ../LUFA.chm + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 300 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://www.mathjax.org/mathjax + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = YES + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM \ + EEMEM \ + ATTR_PACKED + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = YES + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = YES + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = YES + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = YES + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/LUFA/makefile b/lib/lufa/LUFA/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7e7a9c3afb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/LUFA/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,40 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# --------------------------------------- +# Makefile for the LUFA library itself. +# --------------------------------------- + +LUFA_VERSION_NUM := $(shell grep LUFA_VERSION_STRING $(LUFA_PATH)/Version.h | cut -d'"' -f2) + +# Default target - no default action when attempting to build the core directly +all: + +# Display the LUFA version of this library copy +version: + @echo "LUFA $(LUFA_VERSION_NUM)" + +LUFA_PATH := . +ARCH := {AVR8,UC3,XMEGA} +DOXYGEN_OVERRIDE_PARAMS := QUIET=YES PROJECT_NUMBER=$(LUFA_VERSION_NUM) + +# Remove all object and associated files from the LUFA library core +clean: + rm -f $(LUFA_SRC_ALL_FILES:%.c=%.o) + rm -f $(LUFA_SRC_ALL_FILES:%.c=%.d) + rm -f $(LUFA_SRC_ALL_FILES:%.c=%.lst) + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk + +.PHONY: all version diff --git a/lib/lufa/Maintenance/lufa_functionlist_transform.xslt b/lib/lufa/Maintenance/lufa_functionlist_transform.xslt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b18f69f2d4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Maintenance/lufa_functionlist_transform.xslt @@ -0,0 +1,19 @@ +<!-- + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +--> + +<!-- Extracts out all function signatures from a combined Doxygen XML output. --> + +<xsl:stylesheet xmlns:xsl="http://www.w3.org/1999/XSL/Transform" version="1.0"> + <xsl:output method="xml" omit-xml-declaration="yes"/> + + <xsl:template match="doxygen"> + <xsl:for-each select="//memberdef[@kind = 'function']"> + <xsl:value-of select="definition"/><xsl:value-of select="argsstring"/><xsl:text>; </xsl:text> + </xsl:for-each> + </xsl:template> +</xsl:stylesheet> diff --git a/lib/lufa/Maintenance/makefile b/lib/lufa/Maintenance/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..93f694e436 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Maintenance/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,94 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +# Maintenance scripts not required by general LUFA users, used for project development purposes. + + +# Path to the root of the LUFA tree +LUFA_ROOT := ../ + +all: + +# Print a list of all filenames and line numbers that exceed an allowed threshold +line-lengths: + awk '{ if (length > 120) { print FILENAME, ":", FNR, "[", length, "]" } }' `find $(LUFA_ROOT) -name *.[ch]` + +# Generate a header containing all library functions +function-list: + $(MAKE) -C $(patsubst %/,%,$(LUFA_ROOT))/LUFA doxygen DOXYGEN_OVERRIDE_PARAMS="GENERATE_HTML=no GENERATE_XML=yes" + @xsltproc $(patsubst %/,%,$(LUFA_ROOT))/LUFA/Documentation/xml/combine.xslt $(patsubst %/,%,$(LUFA_ROOT))/LUFA/Documentation/xml/index.xml > temp.xml + @xsltproc lufa_functionlist_transform.xslt temp.xml > function_list.h + @sort function_list.h | uniq > function_list_unique.h + @rm temp.xml + +# Update all Doxygen configuration files to the latest Doxygen version +upgrade-doxygen: + @echo Upgrading Doxygen files... + @for doxygen_conf in `find $(LUFA_ROOT) -name doxyfile`; do \ + doxygen -u $$doxygen_conf; \ + done; + @echo Doxygen configuration update complete. + +# Make all possible bootloaders for all targets and configurations as set by the BootloaderTest build test +# and store them in a separate directory called "Bootloaders" +bootloaders: + @echo "build_bootloaders:" > BuildMakefile + @printf "\t-mkdir Bootloaders 2>/dev/null\n\n" >> BuildMakefile + + @while read line; \ + do \ + build_cfg=`echo $$line | grep -v "#" | sed 's/ //g'`; \ + \ + if ( test -n "$$build_cfg" ); then \ + build_bootloader=`echo $$build_cfg | cut -d'=' -f1`; \ + build_cfg=`echo $$build_cfg | cut -d'=' -f2-`; \ + \ + build_arch=`echo $$build_cfg | cut -d':' -f1`; \ + build_mcu=`echo $$build_cfg | cut -d':' -f2`; \ + build_board=`echo $$build_cfg | cut -d':' -f3`; \ + build_flashsize=`echo $$build_cfg | cut -d':' -f4`; \ + build_bootsize=`echo $$build_cfg | cut -d':' -f5`; \ + build_fusb=`echo $$build_cfg | cut -d':' -f6`; \ + \ + printf "Found '%s' with FLASH: %3s KB, BOOT: %3s KB, MCU: %12s / %4s, BOARD: %s, F_USB: %sMHz\n" $$build_bootloader $$build_flashsize $$build_bootsize $$build_mcu $$build_arch $$build_board $$build_fusb; \ + \ + printf "\t-mkdir Bootloaders/%s 2>/dev/null\n" $$build_bootloader >> BuildMakefile; \ + printf "\t@echo Building '%s' with FLASH: %3s KB, BOOT: %3s KB, MCU: %12s, BOARD: %s, F_USB: %sMHz\n" $$build_bootloader $$build_flashsize $$build_bootsize $$build_mcu $$build_board $$build_fusb >> BuildMakefile; \ + printf "\t$(MAKE) -C $(patsubst %/,%,$(LUFA_ROOT))/Bootloaders/%s/ clean hex ARCH=%s MCU=%s BOARD=%s FLASH_SIZE_KB=%s BOOT_SECTION_SIZE_KB=%s F_USB=%s000000 DEBUG_LEVEL=0\n" $$build_bootloader $$build_arch $$build_mcu $$build_board $$build_flashsize $$build_bootsize $$build_fusb >> BuildMakefile; \ + printf "\tmv $(patsubst %/,%,$(LUFA_ROOT))/Bootloaders/%s/Bootloader%s.hex Bootloaders/%s/%s-%s-%s-BOARD_%s-BOOT_%sKB-%sMHz.hex\n\n" $$build_bootloader $$build_bootloader $$build_bootloader $$build_bootloader $$build_arch $$build_mcu $$build_board $$build_bootsize $$build_fusb >> BuildMakefile; \ + fi; \ + done < $(patsubst %/,%,$(LUFA_ROOT))/BuildTests/BootloaderTest/BootloaderDeviceMap.cfg + + $(MAKE) -f BuildMakefile build_bootloaders + cp $(patsubst %/,%,$(LUFA_ROOT))/LUFA/License.txt Bootloaders + rm -f BuildMakefile + +# Check the working branch documentation, ensure no placeholder values +check-documentation-placeholders: + @echo Checking for release suitability... + @if ( grep " LUFA_VERSION_RELEASE_TYPE " $(patsubst %/,%,$(LUFA_ROOT))/LUFA/Version.h | grep "LUFA_VERSION_RELEASE_TYPE_DEVELOPMENT" > /dev/null ;); then \ + echo " ERROR: Version header has not been updated for release!"; \ + exit 1; \ + fi; + @if ( grep "XXXXXX" $(patsubst %/,%,$(LUFA_ROOT))/LUFA/DoxygenPages/*.txt > /dev/null ;); then \ + echo " ERROR: Doxygen documentation has not been updated for release!"; \ + exit 1; \ + fi; + @echo Done. + +# Validate the working branch - compile all documentation, demos/projects/examples and run build tests +validate-branch: + $(MAKE) -C $(patsubst %/,%,$(LUFA_ROOT)) doxygen + $(MAKE) -C $(patsubst %/,%,$(LUFA_ROOT)) all DEBUG_LEVEL=0 + $(MAKE) -C $(patsubst %/,%,$(LUFA_ROOT))/BuildTests all + +# Validate the working branch for general release, check for placeholder documentation then build and test everything +validate-release: check-documentation-placeholders validate-branch + + +.PHONY: all upgrade-doxygen bootloaders check-documentation-placeholders validate-branch diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISP-MKII.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISP-MKII.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a734d960ba --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISP-MKII.c @@ -0,0 +1,164 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the AVRISP project. This file contains the main tasks of + * the project and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "AVRISP-MKII.h" + +#if (BOARD != BOARD_NONE) + /* Some board hardware definitions (e.g. the Arduino Micro) have their LEDs defined on the same pins + as the ISP, PDI or TPI interfaces (see the accompanying project documentation). If a board other + than NONE is selected (to enable the LED driver with the programmer) you should double-check that + no conflicts will occur. If there is a conflict, turn off the LEDs (set BOARD to NONE in the makefile) + or define a custom board driver (see the LUFA manual) with alternative LED mappings. + */ + #warning Board specific drivers have been selected; make sure the board LED driver does not conflict with the programmer ISP/PDI/TPI interfaces. +#endif + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + V2Protocol_Init(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + #if (BOARD == BOARD_USBTINYMKII) + /* On the USBTINY-MKII target, there is a secondary LED which indicates the current selected power + mode - either VBUS, or sourced from the VTARGET pin of the programming connectors */ + LEDs_ChangeLEDs(LEDMASK_VBUSPOWER, (PIND & (1 << 0)) ? 0 : LEDMASK_VBUSPOWER); + #endif + + AVRISP_Task(); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + #if defined(RESET_TOGGLES_LIBUSB_COMPAT) + UpdateCurrentCompatibilityMode(); + #endif + + /* USB Stack Initialization */ + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + /* Setup AVRISP Data OUT endpoint */ + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_OUT_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, AVRISP_DATA_EPSIZE, 1); + + /* Setup AVRISP Data IN endpoint if it is using a physically different endpoint */ + if ((AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK) != (AVRISP_DATA_OUT_EPADDR & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK)) + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, AVRISP_DATA_EPSIZE, 1); + + /* Indicate endpoint configuration success or failure */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Processes incoming V2 Protocol commands from the host, returning a response when required. */ +void AVRISP_Task(void) +{ + /* Device must be connected and configured for the task to run */ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + V2Params_UpdateParamValues(); + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_OUT_EPADDR); + + /* Check to see if a V2 Protocol command has been received */ + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_BUSY); + + /* Pass off processing of the V2 Protocol command to the V2 Protocol handler */ + V2Protocol_ProcessCommand(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + } +} + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + * + * \param[in] wValue Descriptor type and index to retrieve + * \param[in] wIndex Sub-index to retrieve (such as a localized string language) + * \param[out] DescriptorAddress Address of the retrieved descriptor + * + * \return Length of the retrieved descriptor in bytes, or NO_DESCRIPTOR if the descriptor was not found + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + return AVRISP_GetDescriptor(wValue, wIndex, DescriptorAddress); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISP-MKII.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISP-MKII.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ae2d041484 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISP-MKII.h @@ -0,0 +1,90 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for AVRISP.c. + */ + +#ifndef _AVRISP_H_ +#define _AVRISP_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + #if defined(ADC) + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/ADC.h> + #endif + + #include "AVRISPDescriptors.h" + #include "Lib/V2Protocol.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY LEDS_LED2 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_BUSY (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the target is being powered by VBUS. */ + #define LEDMASK_VBUSPOWER LEDS_LED3 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void AVRISP_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISP-MKII.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISP-MKII.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..76d612ec05 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISP-MKII.txt @@ -0,0 +1,346 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage AVRISP MKII Programmer Project + * + * \section Sec_Compat Project Compatibility + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this project. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) - <i>8KB versions with reduced features only</i> + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this project. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Vendor Specific Class</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>Atmel AVRISP MKII Protocol Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description + * + * Firmware for an Atmel Studio compatible AVRISP-MKII clone programmer. This project will enable the USB + * AVR series of microcontrollers to act as a clone of the official Atmel AVRISP-MKII programmer, usable within + * Atmel Studio or with any software capable of driving a real Atmel AVRISP-MKII programmer. In its most + * basic form, it allows for the programming of AVR TINY, MEGA and XMEGA devices at the programmer's VCC voltage from + * within Atmel Studio with no special hardware other than the USB AVR and the parts needed for the USB + * interface. If the user desires, more advanced circuits incorporating level conversion can be made to allow for the + * programming of target AVRs running at a different voltage to the programmer. + * + * This device spoofs Atmel's official AVRISP-MKII device PID so that it remains compatible with Atmel's AVRISP-MKII + * drivers. It is currently tested working under the following configurations: + * + * - <b>Windows:</b> Atmel Studio 7, with alternative driver + * - <b>Windows:</b> AVRDUDE 6.2, with alternative driver + * - <b>Linux:</b> AVRDUDE 6.1 + * + * <b>Note that this clone requires a libUSB based driver under Windows,</b> due to an incompatible change in the official + * Jungo based driver. The alternative driver given here will function with both real and clone AVRISP devices in Atmel + * Studio 7 onwards under Windows - and as a bonus, also provides AVRDude access to the programmer. + * + * As of Atmel Studio version 7.0.1417 the legacy Jungo driver has been deprecated in favor of an official libUSB based + * driver, making the driver packaged here superfluous. Use the driver packaged here only if you are still using an earlier + * Atmel Studio 7 build, otherwise the official Atmel libUSB driver should be used. + * + * Note that this design currently has the following limitations: + * - No reversed/shorted target connector detection and notification + * - A separate header is required for each of the ISP, PDI and TPI programming protocols that the user wishes to use + * + * On AVR models with an ADC converter, the USB AVR's AVCC pin should be tied to 5V (e.g. VBUS) and the + * \c VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL token should be set to an appropriate ADC channel number in the project makefile for VTARGET + * detection to operate correctly. On models without an ADC converter, VTARGET will report a fixed 3.3V level at all times + * which should allow the programmer to remain compatible at the protocol level with all AVR devices. + * + * While this application can be compiled for USB AVRs with as little as 8KB of FLASH, for full functionality 16KB or more + * of FLASH is required. On 8KB devices, ISP or PDI/TPI protocol programming support can be disabled to reduce program size. + * + * \section Sec_KnownIssues Known Issues: + * + * \par XMEGA EEPROM programming fails in some cases. + * Several users have reported that XMEGA EEPROM programming fails unless the chip is erased first. If a non-blank EEPROM + * is present, writing further EEPROM data causes corruption. + * <a href="https://github.com/abcminiuser/lufa/issues/25">LUFA issue tracker entry</a>. + * + * \section Sec_Installation Installation + * The programmer supports multiple platforms, both Windows and Linux. + * + * \subsection SSec_LinuxInstallation Linux Installation + * On Linux systems, the programmer should be usable out of the box with no special setup other than (on some systems) + * editing of the system permissions to allow the programmer to be used from a non-elevated (root) context. The programmer + * is compatible with the free open source AVRDude programming software project. + * + * \subsection SSec_WindowsInstallation Windows Installation + * On Windows systems, due to an unfortunate limitation of the USB AVR devices and the Atmel Studio platform, the programmer + * requires an alternative libUSB based driver. Uninstall the existing Jungo driver for the device (if installed) and replace + * it with the driver that ships with this project, to enable access to the programmer in Atmel Studio and AVRDUDE. + * + * \section Sec_ISP ISP Connections + * Connections to the device for SPI programming (when enabled): + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Programmer Pin:</b></th> + * <th><b>Target Device Pin:</b></th> + * <th><b>ISP 6 Pin Layout:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MISO</td> + * <td>PDO</td> + * <td>1</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ADCx <b><sup>1</sup></b></td> + * <td>VTARGET</td> + * <td>2</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>SCLK</td> + * <td>SCLK</td> + * <td>3</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MOSI</td> + * <td>PDI</td> + * <td>4</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>PORTx.y <b><sup>2</sup></b></td> + * <td>/RESET</td> + * <td>5</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>GND</td> + * <td>GND</td> + * <td>6</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * In addition, the AVR's OCR1A pin will generate a 4MHz clock, to act as an external rescue device clock if the + * fuses have been mis-set. To use the recovery clock, connect the OCR1A pin of the USB AVR to the target AVR's + * XTAL1 pin, and set the ISP programming speed to 125KHz (note: other ISP speeds will not work correctly). + * + * <b><sup>1</sup></b> <i>Optional, see \ref Sec_Options section - for USB AVRs with ADC modules only</i> \n + * <b><sup>2</sup></b> <i>See AUX line related tokens in the \ref Sec_Options section</i> + * + * \section Sec_PDI PDI Connections + * Connections to the device for PDI programming (when enabled): + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Programmer Pin:</b></th> + * <th><b>Target Device Pin:</b></th> + * <th><b>PDI 6 Pin Layout:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Tx/Rx <b><sup>2</sup></b></td> + * <td>DATA</td> + * <td>1</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ADCx <b><sup>1</sup></b></td> + * <td>VTARGET</td> + * <td>2</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>3</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>4</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>XCK</td> + * <td>CLOCK</td> + * <td>5</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>GND</td> + * <td>GND</td> + * <td>6</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * <b><sup>1</sup></b> <i>Optional, see \ref Sec_Options section - for USB AVRs with ADC modules only</i> \n + * <b><sup>2</sup></b> <i>The AVR's Tx and Rx become the DATA line when connected together via a pair of 220 ohm resistors</i> \n + * + * \section Sec_TPI TPI Connections + * Connections to the device for TPI programming (when enabled): + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Programmer Pin:</b></th> + * <th><b>Target Device Pin:</b></th> + * <th><b>TPI 6 Pin Layout:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Tx/Rx <b><sup>2</sup></b></td> + * <td>DATA</td> + * <td>1</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ADCx <b><sup>1</sup></b></td> + * <td>VTARGET</td> + * <td>2</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>XCK <b><sup>2</sup></b></td> + * <td>CLOCK</td> + * <td>3</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * <td>4</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>PORTx.y <b><sup>3</sup></b></td> + * <td>/RESET</td> + * <td>5</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>GND</td> + * <td>GND</td> + * <td>6</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * <b><sup>1</sup></b> <i>Optional, see \ref Sec_Options section - for USB AVRs with ADC modules only</i> \n + * <b><sup>2</sup></b> <i>The AVR's Tx and Rx become the DATA line when connected together via a pair of 220 ohm resistors</i> \n + * <b><sup>3</sup></b> <i>See AUX line related tokens in the \ref Sec_Options section</i> + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this project, which can control the project behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AUX_LINE_PORT</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>PORT register for the programmer's AUX target line. The use of this line varies between the programming protocols, + * but is generally used for the target's /RESET line. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for the XPLAIN board.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AUX_LINE_PIN</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>PIN register for the programmer's AUX target line. The use of this line varies between the programming protocols, + * but is generally used for the target's /RESET line. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for the XPLAIN board.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AUX_LINE_DDR</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>DDR register for the programmer's AUX target line. The use of this line varies between the programming protocols, + * but is generally used for the target's /RESET line. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for the XPLAIN board.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AUX_LINE_MASK</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Mask for the programmer's AUX target line. The use of this line varies between the programming protocols, + * but is generally used for the target's /RESET line. <b>Must not be the AVR's /SS pin</b>. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for the XPLAIN board.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>ADC channel number (on supported AVRs) to use for VTARGET level detection, if NO_VTARGET_DETECT is not defined. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for targets lacking an ADC.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Define to enable SPI programming protocol support. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for the XPLAIN board.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Define to enable PDI and TPI programming protocol support. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for the XPLAIN board.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>NO_VTARGET_DETECT</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Define to disable VTARGET sampling and reporting on AVR models with an ADC converter. This will cause the programmer + * to report a fixed 3.3V target voltage to the host regardless of the real target voltage. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for targets lacking an ADC.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>VTARGET_REF_VOLTS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Indicates the programmer AVR's AVCC reference voltage when measuring the target's supply voltage. Note that the supply + * voltage should never exceed the reference voltage on the programmer AVR without some form of protection to prevent damage + * to the ADC. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for targets lacking an ADC, or when NO_VTARGET_DETECT is defined.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>VTARGET_USE_INTERNAL_REF</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Selects the internal 2.56V ADC reference voltage, instead of using the AVR's VREF pin. When enabled, this option will + * override the VTARGET_REF_VOLTS configuration option. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for targets lacking an ADC, or when NO_VTARGET_DETECT is defined.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>VTARGET_SCALE_FACTOR</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Indicates the target's supply voltage scale factor when applied to the ADC. A simple resistive divider can be used on the + * ADC pin for measuring the target's supply voltage, so that voltages above the programmer AVR's AVCC reference voltage can be + * measured. This should be the reciprocal of the division performed - e.g. if the VTARGET voltage is halved, this should be set + * to 2. + * \n \n <i>Ignored when compiled for targets lacking an ADC, or when NO_VTARGET_DETECT is defined.</i></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>XCK_RESCUE_CLOCK_ENABLE</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Define to move the ISP rescue clock to the AVR's XCK pin instead of the OCR1A output pin. This is useful for existing programming + * hardware that does not expose the OCR1A pin of the AVR, but <i>may</i> cause some issues with PDI programming mode.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>INVERTED_ISP_MISO</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Define to invert the received data on the ISP MISO line. This is sometimes needed depending on the level translation hardware used, + * if the translator hardware inverts the received logic level.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>FIRMWARE_VERSION_MINOR</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Define to set the minor firmware revision nunber reported to the host on request. By default this will use a firmware version compatible + * with the latest Atmel IDE version, however if desired the reported minor value can be adjusted here.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISPDescriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISPDescriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f4210fbbbf --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISPDescriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,203 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "AVRISPDescriptors.h" + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM AVRISP_DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_VendorSpecificClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2104, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(2,0,0), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = AVRISP_STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = AVRISP_STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = AVRISP_STRING_ID_Serial, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const AVRISP_USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM AVRISP_ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(AVRISP_USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .AVRISP_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AVRISP, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = USB_CSCP_VendorSpecificClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .AVRISP_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = AVRISP_DATA_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x0A + }, + + .AVRISP_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = AVRISP_DATA_OUT_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = AVRISP_DATA_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x0A + }, +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM AVRISP_LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM AVRISP_ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"ATMEL"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM AVRISP_ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"AVRISP mkII"); + +/** Serial number string. This is a Unicode string containing the device's unique serial number, expressed as a + * series of uppercase hexadecimal digits. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM AVRISP_SerialString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"000200012345\0" + // Note: Real AVRISP-MKII has the embedded NUL byte, bug in firmware? +); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t AVRISP_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &AVRISP_DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &AVRISP_ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(AVRISP_USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case AVRISP_STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &AVRISP_LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&AVRISP_LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case AVRISP_STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &AVRISP_ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&AVRISP_ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case AVRISP_STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &AVRISP_ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&AVRISP_ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + case AVRISP_STRING_ID_Serial: + Address = &AVRISP_SerialString; + Size = AVRISP_SerialString.Header.Size; + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISPDescriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISPDescriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..56dcf25a9b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/AVRISPDescriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,100 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the AVRISP data OUT endpoint. */ + #define AVRISP_DATA_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /** Endpoint address of the AVRISP data IN endpoint. */ + #define AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 2) + + /** Size in bytes of the AVRISP data endpoint. */ + #define AVRISP_DATA_EPSIZE 64 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Atmel AVRISP-MKII Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t AVRISP_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t AVRISP_DataInEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t AVRISP_DataOutEndpoint; + } AVRISP_USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_AVRISP = 0, /**< AVRISP interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum AVRISP_StringDescriptors_t + { + AVRISP_STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + AVRISP_STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + AVRISP_STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + AVRISP_STRING_ID_Serial = 3, /**< Serial number string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t AVRISP_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a2d15abdc9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,68 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define AUX_LINE_PORT PORTB + #define AUX_LINE_PIN PINB + #define AUX_LINE_DDR DDRB + #if (BOARD == BOARD_U2S) + #define AUX_LINE_MASK (1 << 0) + #else + #define AUX_LINE_MASK (1 << 4) + #endif + + #define ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL + #define ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL + + #define VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL 2 + #define VTARGET_REF_VOLTS 5 + #define VTARGET_SCALE_FACTOR 1 +// #define VTARGET_USE_INTERNAL_REF + #define NO_VTARGET_DETECT +// #define XCK_RESCUE_CLOCK_ENABLE +// #define INVERTED_ISP_MISO + +// #define FIRMWARE_VERSION_MINOR 0x11 + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ed160230ca --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT + #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS + #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 16 + #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT + #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP + #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPProtocol.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPProtocol.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6553504d5e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPProtocol.c @@ -0,0 +1,531 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * ISP Protocol handler, to process V2 Protocol wrapped ISP commands used in Atmel programmer devices. + */ + +#include "ISPProtocol.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + +/** Handler for the CMD_ENTER_PROGMODE_ISP command, which attempts to enter programming mode on + * the attached device, returning success or failure back to the host. + */ +void ISPProtocol_EnterISPMode(void) +{ + struct + { + uint8_t TimeoutMS; + uint8_t PinStabDelayMS; + uint8_t ExecutionDelayMS; + uint8_t SynchLoops; + uint8_t ByteDelay; + uint8_t PollValue; + uint8_t PollIndex; + uint8_t EnterProgBytes[4]; + } Enter_ISP_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&Enter_ISP_Params, sizeof(Enter_ISP_Params), NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + uint8_t ResponseStatus = STATUS_CMD_FAILED; + + CurrentAddress = 0; + + /* Perform execution delay, initialize SPI bus */ + ISPProtocol_DelayMS(Enter_ISP_Params.ExecutionDelayMS); + ISPTarget_EnableTargetISP(); + + ISPTarget_ChangeTargetResetLine(true); + ISPProtocol_DelayMS(Enter_ISP_Params.PinStabDelayMS); + + /* Continuously attempt to synchronize with the target until either the number of attempts specified + * by the host has exceeded, or the the device sends back the expected response values */ + while (Enter_ISP_Params.SynchLoops-- && TimeoutTicksRemaining) + { + uint8_t ResponseBytes[4]; + + for (uint8_t RByte = 0; RByte < sizeof(ResponseBytes); RByte++) + { + ISPProtocol_DelayMS(Enter_ISP_Params.ByteDelay); + ResponseBytes[RByte] = ISPTarget_TransferByte(Enter_ISP_Params.EnterProgBytes[RByte]); + } + + /* Check if polling disabled, or if the polled value matches the expected value */ + if (!(Enter_ISP_Params.PollIndex) || (ResponseBytes[Enter_ISP_Params.PollIndex - 1] == Enter_ISP_Params.PollValue)) + { + ResponseStatus = STATUS_CMD_OK; + break; + } + else + { + ISPTarget_ChangeTargetResetLine(false); + ISPProtocol_DelayMS(Enter_ISP_Params.PinStabDelayMS); + ISPTarget_ChangeTargetResetLine(true); + ISPProtocol_DelayMS(Enter_ISP_Params.PinStabDelayMS); + } + } + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_ENTER_PROGMODE_ISP); + Endpoint_Write_8(ResponseStatus); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_LEAVE_ISP command, which releases the target from programming mode. */ +void ISPProtocol_LeaveISPMode(void) +{ + struct + { + uint8_t PreDelayMS; + uint8_t PostDelayMS; + } Leave_ISP_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&Leave_ISP_Params, sizeof(Leave_ISP_Params), NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + /* Perform pre-exit delay, release the target /RESET, disable the SPI bus and perform the post-exit delay */ + ISPProtocol_DelayMS(Leave_ISP_Params.PreDelayMS); + ISPTarget_ChangeTargetResetLine(false); + ISPTarget_DisableTargetISP(); + ISPProtocol_DelayMS(Leave_ISP_Params.PostDelayMS); + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_LEAVE_PROGMODE_ISP); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_PROGRAM_FLASH_ISP and CMD_PROGRAM_EEPROM_ISP commands, writing out bytes, + * words or pages of data to the attached device. + * + * \param[in] V2Command Issued V2 Protocol command byte from the host + */ +void ISPProtocol_ProgramMemory(uint8_t V2Command) +{ + struct + { + uint16_t BytesToWrite; + uint8_t ProgrammingMode; + uint8_t DelayMS; + uint8_t ProgrammingCommands[3]; + uint8_t PollValue1; + uint8_t PollValue2; + uint8_t ProgData[256]; // Note, the Jungo driver has a very short ACK timeout period, need to buffer the + } Write_Memory_Params; // whole page and ACK the packet as fast as possible to prevent it from aborting + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&Write_Memory_Params, (sizeof(Write_Memory_Params) - + sizeof(Write_Memory_Params.ProgData)), NULL); + Write_Memory_Params.BytesToWrite = SwapEndian_16(Write_Memory_Params.BytesToWrite); + + if (Write_Memory_Params.BytesToWrite > sizeof(Write_Memory_Params.ProgData)) + { + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + Endpoint_Write_8(V2Command); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_FAILED); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + return; + } + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&Write_Memory_Params.ProgData, Write_Memory_Params.BytesToWrite, NULL); + + // The driver will terminate transfers that are a round multiple of the endpoint bank in size with a ZLP, need + // to catch this and discard it before continuing on with packet processing to prevent communication issues + if (((sizeof(uint8_t) + sizeof(Write_Memory_Params) - sizeof(Write_Memory_Params.ProgData)) + + Write_Memory_Params.BytesToWrite) % AVRISP_DATA_EPSIZE == 0) + { + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + } + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + uint8_t ProgrammingStatus = STATUS_CMD_OK; + uint8_t PollValue = (V2Command == CMD_PROGRAM_FLASH_ISP) ? Write_Memory_Params.PollValue1 : + Write_Memory_Params.PollValue2; + uint16_t PollAddress = 0; + uint8_t* NextWriteByte = Write_Memory_Params.ProgData; + uint16_t PageStartAddress = (CurrentAddress & 0xFFFF); + + for (uint16_t CurrentByte = 0; CurrentByte < Write_Memory_Params.BytesToWrite; CurrentByte++) + { + uint8_t ByteToWrite = *(NextWriteByte++); + uint8_t ProgrammingMode = Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingMode; + + /* Check to see if we need to send a LOAD EXTENDED ADDRESS command to the target */ + if (MustLoadExtendedAddress) + { + ISPTarget_LoadExtendedAddress(); + MustLoadExtendedAddress = false; + } + + ISPTarget_SendByte(Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingCommands[0]); + ISPTarget_SendByte(CurrentAddress >> 8); + ISPTarget_SendByte(CurrentAddress & 0xFF); + ISPTarget_SendByte(ByteToWrite); + + /* AVR FLASH addressing requires us to modify the write command based on if we are writing a high + * or low byte at the current word address */ + if (V2Command == CMD_PROGRAM_FLASH_ISP) + Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingCommands[0] ^= READ_WRITE_HIGH_BYTE_MASK; + + /* Check to see if we have a valid polling address */ + if (!(PollAddress) && (ByteToWrite != PollValue)) + { + if ((CurrentByte & 0x01) && (V2Command == CMD_PROGRAM_FLASH_ISP)) + Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingCommands[2] |= READ_WRITE_HIGH_BYTE_MASK; + else + Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingCommands[2] &= ~READ_WRITE_HIGH_BYTE_MASK; + + PollAddress = (CurrentAddress & 0xFFFF); + } + + /* If in word programming mode, commit the byte to the target's memory */ + if (!(ProgrammingMode & PROG_MODE_PAGED_WRITES_MASK)) + { + /* If the current polling address is invalid, switch to timed delay write completion mode */ + if (!(PollAddress) && !(ProgrammingMode & PROG_MODE_WORD_READYBUSY_MASK)) + ProgrammingMode = (ProgrammingMode & ~PROG_MODE_WORD_VALUE_MASK) | PROG_MODE_WORD_TIMEDELAY_MASK; + + ProgrammingStatus = ISPTarget_WaitForProgComplete(ProgrammingMode, PollAddress, PollValue, + Write_Memory_Params.DelayMS, + Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingCommands[2]); + + /* Abort the programming loop early if the byte/word programming failed */ + if (ProgrammingStatus != STATUS_CMD_OK) + break; + + /* Must reset the polling address afterwards, so it is not erroneously used for the next byte */ + PollAddress = 0; + } + + /* EEPROM just increments the address each byte, flash needs to increment on each word and + * also check to ensure that a LOAD EXTENDED ADDRESS command is issued each time the extended + * address boundary has been crossed during FLASH memory programming */ + if ((CurrentByte & 0x01) || (V2Command == CMD_PROGRAM_EEPROM_ISP)) + { + CurrentAddress++; + + if ((V2Command == CMD_PROGRAM_FLASH_ISP) && !(CurrentAddress & 0xFFFF)) + MustLoadExtendedAddress = true; + } + } + + /* If the current page must be committed, send the PROGRAM PAGE command to the target */ + if (Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingMode & PROG_MODE_COMMIT_PAGE_MASK) + { + ISPTarget_SendByte(Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingCommands[1]); + ISPTarget_SendByte(PageStartAddress >> 8); + ISPTarget_SendByte(PageStartAddress & 0xFF); + ISPTarget_SendByte(0x00); + + /* Check if polling is enabled and possible, if not switch to timed delay mode */ + if ((Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingMode & PROG_MODE_PAGED_VALUE_MASK) && !(PollAddress)) + { + Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingMode = (Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingMode & ~PROG_MODE_PAGED_VALUE_MASK) | + PROG_MODE_PAGED_TIMEDELAY_MASK; + } + + ProgrammingStatus = ISPTarget_WaitForProgComplete(Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingMode, PollAddress, PollValue, + Write_Memory_Params.DelayMS, + Write_Memory_Params.ProgrammingCommands[2]); + + /* Check to see if the FLASH address has crossed the extended address boundary */ + if ((V2Command == CMD_PROGRAM_FLASH_ISP) && !(CurrentAddress & 0xFFFF)) + MustLoadExtendedAddress = true; + } + + Endpoint_Write_8(V2Command); + Endpoint_Write_8(ProgrammingStatus); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_READ_FLASH_ISP and CMD_READ_EEPROM_ISP commands, reading in bytes, + * words or pages of data from the attached device. + * + * \param[in] V2Command Issued V2 Protocol command byte from the host + */ +void ISPProtocol_ReadMemory(uint8_t V2Command) +{ + struct + { + uint16_t BytesToRead; + uint8_t ReadMemoryCommand; + } Read_Memory_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&Read_Memory_Params, sizeof(Read_Memory_Params), NULL); + Read_Memory_Params.BytesToRead = SwapEndian_16(Read_Memory_Params.BytesToRead); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + Endpoint_Write_8(V2Command); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + + /* Read each byte from the device and write them to the packet for the host */ + for (uint16_t CurrentByte = 0; CurrentByte < Read_Memory_Params.BytesToRead; CurrentByte++) + { + /* Check to see if we need to send a LOAD EXTENDED ADDRESS command to the target */ + if (MustLoadExtendedAddress) + { + ISPTarget_LoadExtendedAddress(); + MustLoadExtendedAddress = false; + } + + /* Read the next byte from the desired memory space in the device */ + ISPTarget_SendByte(Read_Memory_Params.ReadMemoryCommand); + ISPTarget_SendByte(CurrentAddress >> 8); + ISPTarget_SendByte(CurrentAddress & 0xFF); + Endpoint_Write_8(ISPTarget_ReceiveByte()); + + /* Check if the endpoint bank is currently full, if so send the packet */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + } + + /* AVR FLASH addressing requires us to modify the read command based on if we are reading a high + * or low byte at the current word address */ + if (V2Command == CMD_READ_FLASH_ISP) + Read_Memory_Params.ReadMemoryCommand ^= READ_WRITE_HIGH_BYTE_MASK; + + /* EEPROM just increments the address each byte, flash needs to increment on each word and + * also check to ensure that a LOAD EXTENDED ADDRESS command is issued each time the extended + * address boundary has been crossed */ + if ((CurrentByte & 0x01) || (V2Command == CMD_READ_EEPROM_ISP)) + { + CurrentAddress++; + + if ((V2Command != CMD_READ_EEPROM_ISP) && !(CurrentAddress & 0xFFFF)) + MustLoadExtendedAddress = true; + } + } + + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + + bool IsEndpointFull = !(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed()); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Ensure last packet is a short packet to terminate the transfer */ + if (IsEndpointFull) + { + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + } +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_CHI_ERASE_ISP command, clearing the target's FLASH memory. */ +void ISPProtocol_ChipErase(void) +{ + struct + { + uint8_t EraseDelayMS; + uint8_t PollMethod; + uint8_t EraseCommandBytes[4]; + } Erase_Chip_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&Erase_Chip_Params, sizeof(Erase_Chip_Params), NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + uint8_t ResponseStatus = STATUS_CMD_OK; + + /* Send the chip erase commands as given by the host to the device */ + for (uint8_t SByte = 0; SByte < sizeof(Erase_Chip_Params.EraseCommandBytes); SByte++) + ISPTarget_SendByte(Erase_Chip_Params.EraseCommandBytes[SByte]); + + /* Use appropriate command completion check as given by the host (delay or busy polling) */ + if (!(Erase_Chip_Params.PollMethod)) + ISPProtocol_DelayMS(Erase_Chip_Params.EraseDelayMS); + else + ResponseStatus = ISPTarget_WaitWhileTargetBusy(); + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_CHIP_ERASE_ISP); + Endpoint_Write_8(ResponseStatus); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_READ_FUSE_ISP, CMD_READ_LOCK_ISP, CMD_READ_SIGNATURE_ISP and CMD_READ_OSCCAL commands, + * reading the requested configuration byte from the device. + * + * \param[in] V2Command Issued V2 Protocol command byte from the host + */ +void ISPProtocol_ReadFuseLockSigOSCCAL(uint8_t V2Command) +{ + struct + { + uint8_t RetByte; + uint8_t ReadCommandBytes[4]; + } Read_FuseLockSigOSCCAL_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&Read_FuseLockSigOSCCAL_Params, sizeof(Read_FuseLockSigOSCCAL_Params), NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + uint8_t ResponseBytes[4]; + + /* Send the Fuse or Lock byte read commands as given by the host to the device, store response */ + for (uint8_t RByte = 0; RByte < sizeof(ResponseBytes); RByte++) + ResponseBytes[RByte] = ISPTarget_TransferByte(Read_FuseLockSigOSCCAL_Params.ReadCommandBytes[RByte]); + + Endpoint_Write_8(V2Command); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + Endpoint_Write_8(ResponseBytes[Read_FuseLockSigOSCCAL_Params.RetByte - 1]); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_WRITE_FUSE_ISP and CMD_WRITE_LOCK_ISP commands, writing the requested configuration + * byte to the device. + * + * \param[in] V2Command Issued V2 Protocol command byte from the host + */ +void ISPProtocol_WriteFuseLock(uint8_t V2Command) +{ + struct + { + uint8_t WriteCommandBytes[4]; + } Write_FuseLockSig_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&Write_FuseLockSig_Params, sizeof(Write_FuseLockSig_Params), NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + /* Send the Fuse or Lock byte program commands as given by the host to the device */ + for (uint8_t SByte = 0; SByte < sizeof(Write_FuseLockSig_Params.WriteCommandBytes); SByte++) + ISPTarget_SendByte(Write_FuseLockSig_Params.WriteCommandBytes[SByte]); + + Endpoint_Write_8(V2Command); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_SPI_MULTI command, writing and reading arbitrary SPI data to and from the attached device. */ +void ISPProtocol_SPIMulti(void) +{ + struct + { + uint8_t TxBytes; + uint8_t RxBytes; + uint8_t RxStartAddr; + uint8_t TxData[255]; + } SPI_Multi_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&SPI_Multi_Params, (sizeof(SPI_Multi_Params) - sizeof(SPI_Multi_Params.TxData)), NULL); + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&SPI_Multi_Params.TxData, SPI_Multi_Params.TxBytes, NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_SPI_MULTI); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + + uint8_t CurrTxPos = 0; + uint8_t CurrRxPos = 0; + + /* Write out bytes to transmit until the start of the bytes to receive is met */ + while (CurrTxPos < SPI_Multi_Params.RxStartAddr) + { + if (CurrTxPos < SPI_Multi_Params.TxBytes) + ISPTarget_SendByte(SPI_Multi_Params.TxData[CurrTxPos]); + else + ISPTarget_SendByte(0); + + CurrTxPos++; + } + + /* Transmit remaining bytes with padding as needed, read in response bytes */ + while (CurrRxPos < SPI_Multi_Params.RxBytes) + { + if (CurrTxPos < SPI_Multi_Params.TxBytes) + Endpoint_Write_8(ISPTarget_TransferByte(SPI_Multi_Params.TxData[CurrTxPos++])); + else + Endpoint_Write_8(ISPTarget_ReceiveByte()); + + /* Check to see if we have filled the endpoint bank and need to send the packet */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + } + + CurrRxPos++; + } + + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + + bool IsEndpointFull = !(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed()); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Ensure last packet is a short packet to terminate the transfer */ + if (IsEndpointFull) + { + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + } +} + +/** Blocking delay for a given number of milliseconds. This provides a simple wrapper around + * the avr-libc provided delay function, so that the delay function can be called with a + * constant value (to prevent run-time floating point operations being required). + * + * \param[in] DelayMS Number of milliseconds to delay for + */ +void ISPProtocol_DelayMS(uint8_t DelayMS) +{ + while (DelayMS-- && TimeoutTicksRemaining) + Delay_MS(1); +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPProtocol.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPProtocol.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..44b339762d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPProtocol.h @@ -0,0 +1,81 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ISPProtocol.c. + */ + +#ifndef _ISP_PROTOCOL_ +#define _ISP_PROTOCOL_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <util/delay.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "../V2Protocol.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + #undef ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL + + #if !defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) + #define ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL + #endif + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** Mask for the reading or writing of the high byte in a FLASH word when issuing a low-level programming command. */ + #define READ_WRITE_HIGH_BYTE_MASK (1 << 3) + + #define PROG_MODE_PAGED_WRITES_MASK (1 << 0) + #define PROG_MODE_WORD_TIMEDELAY_MASK (1 << 1) + #define PROG_MODE_WORD_VALUE_MASK (1 << 2) + #define PROG_MODE_WORD_READYBUSY_MASK (1 << 3) + #define PROG_MODE_PAGED_TIMEDELAY_MASK (1 << 4) + #define PROG_MODE_PAGED_VALUE_MASK (1 << 5) + #define PROG_MODE_PAGED_READYBUSY_MASK (1 << 6) + #define PROG_MODE_COMMIT_PAGE_MASK (1 << 7) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void ISPProtocol_EnterISPMode(void); + void ISPProtocol_LeaveISPMode(void); + void ISPProtocol_ProgramMemory(const uint8_t V2Command); + void ISPProtocol_ReadMemory(const uint8_t V2Command); + void ISPProtocol_ChipErase(void); + void ISPProtocol_ReadFuseLockSigOSCCAL(const uint8_t V2Command); + void ISPProtocol_WriteFuseLock(const uint8_t V2Command); + void ISPProtocol_SPIMulti(void); + void ISPProtocol_DelayMS(uint8_t DelayMS); +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPTarget.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPTarget.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197b62275d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPTarget.c @@ -0,0 +1,370 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Target-related functions for the ISP Protocol decoder. + */ + +#include "ISPTarget.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + +/** List of hardware SPI prescaler masks for possible AVRStudio ISP programming speeds. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +static const uint8_t SPIMaskFromSCKDuration[] PROGMEM = +{ +#if (F_CPU == 8000000) + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_2, // AVRStudio = 8MHz SPI, Actual = 4MHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_2, // AVRStudio = 4MHz SPI, Actual = 4MHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_4, // AVRStudio = 2MHz SPI, Actual = 2MHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_8, // AVRStudio = 1MHz SPI, Actual = 1MHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_16, // AVRStudio = 500KHz SPI, Actual = 500KHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_32, // AVRStudio = 250KHz SPI, Actual = 250KHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_64, // AVRStudio = 125KHz SPI, Actual = 125KHz SPI +#elif (F_CPU == 16000000) + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_2, // AVRStudio = 8MHz SPI, Actual = 8MHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_4, // AVRStudio = 4MHz SPI, Actual = 4MHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_8, // AVRStudio = 2MHz SPI, Actual = 2MHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_16, // AVRStudio = 1MHz SPI, Actual = 1MHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_32, // AVRStudio = 500KHz SPI, Actual = 500KHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_64, // AVRStudio = 250KHz SPI, Actual = 250KHz SPI + SPI_SPEED_FCPU_DIV_128 // AVRStudio = 125KHz SPI, Actual = 125KHz SPI +#else + #error No SPI prescaler masks for chosen F_CPU speed. +#endif +}; + +/** Lookup table to convert the slower ISP speeds into a compare value for the software SPI driver. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +static const uint16_t TimerCompareFromSCKDuration[] PROGMEM = +{ + TIMER_COMP(96386), TIMER_COMP(89888), TIMER_COMP(84211), TIMER_COMP(79208), TIMER_COMP(74767), + TIMER_COMP(70797), TIMER_COMP(67227), TIMER_COMP(64000), TIMER_COMP(61069), TIMER_COMP(58395), + TIMER_COMP(55945), TIMER_COMP(51613), TIMER_COMP(49690), TIMER_COMP(47905), TIMER_COMP(46243), + TIMER_COMP(43244), TIMER_COMP(41885), TIMER_COMP(39409), TIMER_COMP(38278), TIMER_COMP(36200), + TIMER_COMP(34335), TIMER_COMP(32654), TIMER_COMP(31129), TIMER_COMP(29740), TIMER_COMP(28470), + TIMER_COMP(27304), TIMER_COMP(25724), TIMER_COMP(24768), TIMER_COMP(23461), TIMER_COMP(22285), + TIMER_COMP(21221), TIMER_COMP(20254), TIMER_COMP(19371), TIMER_COMP(18562), TIMER_COMP(17583), + TIMER_COMP(16914), TIMER_COMP(16097), TIMER_COMP(15356), TIMER_COMP(14520), TIMER_COMP(13914), + TIMER_COMP(13224), TIMER_COMP(12599), TIMER_COMP(12031), TIMER_COMP(11511), TIMER_COMP(10944), + TIMER_COMP(10431), TIMER_COMP(9963), TIMER_COMP(9468), TIMER_COMP(9081), TIMER_COMP(8612), + TIMER_COMP(8239), TIMER_COMP(7851), TIMER_COMP(7498), TIMER_COMP(7137), TIMER_COMP(6809), + TIMER_COMP(6478), TIMER_COMP(6178), TIMER_COMP(5879), TIMER_COMP(5607), TIMER_COMP(5359), + TIMER_COMP(5093), TIMER_COMP(4870), TIMER_COMP(4633), TIMER_COMP(4418), TIMER_COMP(4209), + TIMER_COMP(4019), TIMER_COMP(3823), TIMER_COMP(3645), TIMER_COMP(3474), TIMER_COMP(3310), + TIMER_COMP(3161), TIMER_COMP(3011), TIMER_COMP(2869), TIMER_COMP(2734), TIMER_COMP(2611), + TIMER_COMP(2484), TIMER_COMP(2369), TIMER_COMP(2257), TIMER_COMP(2152), TIMER_COMP(2052), + TIMER_COMP(1956), TIMER_COMP(1866), TIMER_COMP(1779), TIMER_COMP(1695), TIMER_COMP(1615), + TIMER_COMP(1539), TIMER_COMP(1468), TIMER_COMP(1398), TIMER_COMP(1333), TIMER_COMP(1271), + TIMER_COMP(1212), TIMER_COMP(1155), TIMER_COMP(1101), TIMER_COMP(1049), TIMER_COMP(1000), + TIMER_COMP(953), TIMER_COMP(909), TIMER_COMP(866), TIMER_COMP(826), TIMER_COMP(787), + TIMER_COMP(750), TIMER_COMP(715), TIMER_COMP(682), TIMER_COMP(650), TIMER_COMP(619), + TIMER_COMP(590), TIMER_COMP(563), TIMER_COMP(536), TIMER_COMP(511), TIMER_COMP(487), + TIMER_COMP(465), TIMER_COMP(443), TIMER_COMP(422), TIMER_COMP(402), TIMER_COMP(384), + TIMER_COMP(366), TIMER_COMP(349), TIMER_COMP(332), TIMER_COMP(317), TIMER_COMP(302), + TIMER_COMP(288), TIMER_COMP(274), TIMER_COMP(261), TIMER_COMP(249), TIMER_COMP(238), + TIMER_COMP(226), TIMER_COMP(216), TIMER_COMP(206), TIMER_COMP(196), TIMER_COMP(187), + TIMER_COMP(178), TIMER_COMP(170), TIMER_COMP(162), TIMER_COMP(154), TIMER_COMP(147), + TIMER_COMP(140), TIMER_COMP(134), TIMER_COMP(128), TIMER_COMP(122), TIMER_COMP(116), + TIMER_COMP(111), TIMER_COMP(105), TIMER_COMP(100), TIMER_COMP(95.4), TIMER_COMP(90.9), + TIMER_COMP(86.6), TIMER_COMP(82.6), TIMER_COMP(78.7), TIMER_COMP(75.0), TIMER_COMP(71.5), + TIMER_COMP(68.2), TIMER_COMP(65.0), TIMER_COMP(61.9), TIMER_COMP(59.0), TIMER_COMP(56.3), + TIMER_COMP(53.6), TIMER_COMP(51.1) +}; + +/** Currently selected SPI driver, either hardware (for fast ISP speeds) or software (for slower ISP speeds). */ +bool HardwareSPIMode = true; + +/** Software SPI data register for sending and receiving */ +static volatile uint8_t SoftSPI_Data; + +/** Number of bits left to transfer in the software SPI driver */ +static volatile uint8_t SoftSPI_BitsRemaining; + + +/** ISR to handle software SPI transmission and reception */ +ISR(TIMER1_COMPA_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + /* Check if rising edge (output next bit) or falling edge (read in next bit) */ + if (!(PINB & (1 << 1))) + { + if (SoftSPI_Data & (1 << 7)) + PORTB |= (1 << 2); + else + PORTB &= ~(1 << 2); + } + else + { + SoftSPI_Data <<= 1; + + if (!(--SoftSPI_BitsRemaining)) + { + TCCR1B = 0; + TIFR1 = (1 << OCF1A); + } + + if (PINB & (1 << 3)) + SoftSPI_Data |= (1 << 0); + } + + /* Fast toggle of PORTB.1 via the PIN register (see datasheet) */ + PINB |= (1 << 1); +} + +/** Initializes the appropriate SPI driver (hardware or software, depending on the selected ISP speed) ready for + * communication with the attached target. + */ +void ISPTarget_EnableTargetISP(void) +{ + uint8_t SCKDuration = V2Params_GetParameterValue(PARAM_SCK_DURATION); + + if (SCKDuration < sizeof(SPIMaskFromSCKDuration)) + { + HardwareSPIMode = true; + + SPI_Init(pgm_read_byte(&SPIMaskFromSCKDuration[SCKDuration]) | SPI_ORDER_MSB_FIRST | + SPI_SCK_LEAD_RISING | SPI_SAMPLE_LEADING | SPI_MODE_MASTER); + } + else + { + HardwareSPIMode = false; + + DDRB |= ((1 << 1) | (1 << 2)); + PORTB |= ((1 << 0) | (1 << 3)); + + ISPTarget_ConfigureSoftwareSPI(SCKDuration); + } +} + +/** Shuts down the current selected SPI driver (hardware or software, depending on the selected ISP speed) so that no + * further communications can occur until the driver is re-initialized. + */ +void ISPTarget_DisableTargetISP(void) +{ + if (HardwareSPIMode) + { + SPI_Disable(); + } + else + { + DDRB &= ~((1 << 1) | (1 << 2)); + PORTB &= ~((1 << 0) | (1 << 3)); + + /* Must re-enable rescue clock once software ISP has exited, as the timer for the rescue clock is + * re-purposed for software SPI */ + ISPTarget_ConfigureRescueClock(); + } +} + +/** Configures the AVR to produce a 4MHz rescue clock out of the OCR1A pin of the AVR, so + * that it can be fed into the XTAL1 pin of an AVR whose fuses have been mis-configured for + * an external clock rather than a crystal. When used, the ISP speed must be 125KHz for this + * functionality to work correctly. + */ +void ISPTarget_ConfigureRescueClock(void) +{ + #if defined(XCK_RESCUE_CLOCK_ENABLE) + /* Configure XCK as an output for the specified AVR model */ + DDRD |= (1 << 5); + + /* Start USART to generate a 4MHz clock on the XCK pin */ + UBRR1 = ((F_CPU / 2 / ISP_RESCUE_CLOCK_SPEED) - 1); + UCSR1B = (1 << TXEN1); + UCSR1C = (1 << UMSEL10) | (1 << UPM11) | (1 << USBS1) | (1 << UCSZ11) | (1 << UCSZ10) | (1 << UCPOL1); + #else + /* Configure OCR1A as an output for the specified AVR model */ + #if defined(USB_SERIES_2_AVR) + DDRC |= (1 << 6); + #else + DDRB |= (1 << 5); + #endif + + /* Start Timer 1 to generate a 4MHz clock on the OCR1A pin */ + TIMSK1 = 0; + TCNT1 = 0; + OCR1A = ((F_CPU / 2 / ISP_RESCUE_CLOCK_SPEED) - 1); + TCCR1A = (1 << COM1A0); + TCCR1B = ((1 << WGM12) | (1 << CS10)); + #endif +} + +/** Configures the AVR's timer ready to produce software SPI for the slower ISP speeds that + * cannot be obtained when using the AVR's hardware SPI module. + * + * \param[in] SCKDuration Duration of the desired software ISP SCK clock + */ +void ISPTarget_ConfigureSoftwareSPI(const uint8_t SCKDuration) +{ + /* Configure Timer 1 for software SPI using the specified SCK duration */ + TIMSK1 = (1 << OCIE1A); + TCNT1 = 0; + OCR1A = pgm_read_word(&TimerCompareFromSCKDuration[SCKDuration - sizeof(SPIMaskFromSCKDuration)]); + TCCR1A = 0; + TCCR1B = 0; +} + +/** Sends and receives a single byte of data to and from the attached target via software SPI. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the attached target + * + * \return Received byte of data from the attached target + */ +uint8_t ISPTarget_TransferSoftSPIByte(const uint8_t Byte) +{ + SoftSPI_Data = Byte; + SoftSPI_BitsRemaining = 8; + + /* Set initial MOSI pin state according to the byte to be transferred */ + if (SoftSPI_Data & (1 << 7)) + PORTB |= (1 << 2); + else + PORTB &= ~(1 << 2); + + TCNT1 = 0; + TCCR1B = ((1 << WGM12) | (1 << CS11)); + while (SoftSPI_BitsRemaining && TimeoutTicksRemaining); + TCCR1B = 0; + + return SoftSPI_Data; +} + +/** Asserts or deasserts the target's reset line, using the correct polarity as set by the host using a SET PARAM command. + * When not asserted, the line is tristated so as not to interfere with normal device operation. + * + * \param[in] ResetTarget Boolean true when the target should be held in reset, \c false otherwise + */ +void ISPTarget_ChangeTargetResetLine(const bool ResetTarget) +{ + if (ResetTarget) + { + AUX_LINE_DDR |= AUX_LINE_MASK; + + if (!(V2Params_GetParameterValue(PARAM_RESET_POLARITY))) + AUX_LINE_PORT |= AUX_LINE_MASK; + else + AUX_LINE_PORT &= ~AUX_LINE_MASK; + } + else + { + AUX_LINE_DDR &= ~AUX_LINE_MASK; + AUX_LINE_PORT &= ~AUX_LINE_MASK; + } +} + +/** Waits until the target has completed the last operation, by continuously polling the device's + * BUSY flag until it is cleared, or until the command timeout period has expired. + * + * \return V2 Protocol status \ref STATUS_CMD_OK if the no timeout occurred, \ref STATUS_RDY_BSY_TOUT otherwise + */ +uint8_t ISPTarget_WaitWhileTargetBusy(void) +{ + do + { + ISPTarget_SendByte(0xF0); + ISPTarget_SendByte(0x00); + ISPTarget_SendByte(0x00); + } + while ((ISPTarget_ReceiveByte() & 0x01) && TimeoutTicksRemaining); + + return (TimeoutTicksRemaining > 0) ? STATUS_CMD_OK : STATUS_RDY_BSY_TOUT; +} + +/** Sends a low-level LOAD EXTENDED ADDRESS command to the target, for addressing of memory beyond the + * 64KB boundary. This sends the command with the correct address as indicated by the current address + * pointer variable set by the host when a SET ADDRESS command is issued. + */ +void ISPTarget_LoadExtendedAddress(void) +{ + ISPTarget_SendByte(LOAD_EXTENDED_ADDRESS_CMD); + ISPTarget_SendByte(0x00); + ISPTarget_SendByte(CurrentAddress >> 16); + ISPTarget_SendByte(0x00); +} + +/** Waits until the last issued target memory programming command has completed, via the check mode given and using + * the given parameters. + * + * \param[in] ProgrammingMode Programming mode used and completion check to use, a mask of \c PROG_MODE_* constants + * \param[in] PollAddress Memory address to poll for completion if polling check mode used + * \param[in] PollValue Poll value to check against if polling check mode used + * \param[in] DelayMS Milliseconds to delay before returning if delay check mode used + * \param[in] ReadMemCommand Device low-level READ MEMORY command to send if value check mode used + * + * \return V2 Protocol status \ref STATUS_CMD_OK if the no timeout occurred, \ref STATUS_RDY_BSY_TOUT or + * \ref STATUS_CMD_TOUT otherwise + */ +uint8_t ISPTarget_WaitForProgComplete(const uint8_t ProgrammingMode, + const uint16_t PollAddress, + const uint8_t PollValue, + const uint8_t DelayMS, + const uint8_t ReadMemCommand) +{ + uint8_t ProgrammingStatus = STATUS_CMD_OK; + + /* Determine method of Programming Complete check */ + switch (ProgrammingMode & ~(PROG_MODE_PAGED_WRITES_MASK | PROG_MODE_COMMIT_PAGE_MASK)) + { + case PROG_MODE_WORD_TIMEDELAY_MASK: + case PROG_MODE_PAGED_TIMEDELAY_MASK: + ISPProtocol_DelayMS(DelayMS); + break; + case PROG_MODE_WORD_VALUE_MASK: + case PROG_MODE_PAGED_VALUE_MASK: + do + { + ISPTarget_SendByte(ReadMemCommand); + ISPTarget_SendByte(PollAddress >> 8); + ISPTarget_SendByte(PollAddress & 0xFF); + } + while ((ISPTarget_TransferByte(0x00) == PollValue) && TimeoutTicksRemaining); + + if (!(TimeoutTicksRemaining)) + ProgrammingStatus = STATUS_CMD_TOUT; + + break; + case PROG_MODE_WORD_READYBUSY_MASK: + case PROG_MODE_PAGED_READYBUSY_MASK: + ProgrammingStatus = ISPTarget_WaitWhileTargetBusy(); + break; + } + + /* Program complete - reset timeout */ + TimeoutTicksRemaining = COMMAND_TIMEOUT_TICKS; + + return ProgrammingStatus; +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPTarget.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPTarget.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5f32f51940 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/ISP/ISPTarget.h @@ -0,0 +1,147 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ISPTarget.c. + */ + +#ifndef _ISP_TARGET_ +#define _ISP_TARGET_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <util/delay.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SPI.h> + + #include "../V2Protocol.h" + #include "ISPProtocol.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + #undef ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL + + #if !defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) + #define ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL + #endif + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** Low level device command to issue an extended FLASH address, for devices with over 128KB of FLASH. */ + #define LOAD_EXTENDED_ADDRESS_CMD 0x4D + + /** Macro to convert an ISP frequency to a number of timer clock cycles for the software SPI driver. */ + #define TIMER_COMP(freq) (((F_CPU / 8) / 2 / freq) - 1) + + /** ISP rescue clock speed in Hz, for clocking targets with incorrectly set fuses. */ + #define ISP_RESCUE_CLOCK_SPEED 4000000 + + /* External Variables: */ + extern bool HardwareSPIMode; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void ISPTarget_EnableTargetISP(void); + void ISPTarget_DisableTargetISP(void); + void ISPTarget_ConfigureRescueClock(void); + void ISPTarget_ConfigureSoftwareSPI(const uint8_t SCKDuration); + uint8_t ISPTarget_TransferSoftSPIByte(const uint8_t Byte); + void ISPTarget_ChangeTargetResetLine(const bool ResetTarget); + uint8_t ISPTarget_WaitWhileTargetBusy(void); + void ISPTarget_LoadExtendedAddress(void); + uint8_t ISPTarget_WaitForProgComplete(const uint8_t ProgrammingMode, + const uint16_t PollAddress, + const uint8_t PollValue, + const uint8_t DelayMS, + const uint8_t ReadMemCommand); + + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Sends a byte of ISP data to the attached target, using the appropriate SPI hardware or + * software routines depending on the selected ISP speed. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the attached target + */ + static inline void ISPTarget_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + if (HardwareSPIMode) + SPI_SendByte(Byte); + else + ISPTarget_TransferSoftSPIByte(Byte); + } + + /** Receives a byte of ISP data from the attached target, using the appropriate + * SPI hardware or software routines depending on the selected ISP speed. + * + * \return Received byte of data from the attached target + */ + static inline uint8_t ISPTarget_ReceiveByte(void) + { + uint8_t ReceivedByte; + + if (HardwareSPIMode) + ReceivedByte = SPI_ReceiveByte(); + else + ReceivedByte = ISPTarget_TransferSoftSPIByte(0x00); + + #if defined(INVERTED_ISP_MISO) + return ~ReceivedByte; + #else + return ReceivedByte; + #endif + } + + /** Sends and receives a byte of ISP data to and from the attached target, using the + * appropriate SPI hardware or software routines depending on the selected ISP speed. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte of data to send to the attached target + * + * \return Received byte of data from the attached target + */ + static inline uint8_t ISPTarget_TransferByte(const uint8_t Byte) + { + uint8_t ReceivedByte; + + if (HardwareSPIMode) + ReceivedByte = SPI_TransferByte(Byte); + else + ReceivedByte = ISPTarget_TransferSoftSPIByte(Byte); + + #if defined(INVERTED_ISP_MISO) + return ~ReceivedByte; + #else + return ReceivedByte; + #endif + } + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2Protocol.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2Protocol.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fd64c5a1e8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2Protocol.c @@ -0,0 +1,267 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * V2Protocol handler, to process V2 Protocol commands used in Atmel programmer devices. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_V2PROTOCOL_C +#include "V2Protocol.h" + +/** Current memory address for FLASH/EEPROM memory read/write commands */ +uint32_t CurrentAddress; + +/** Flag to indicate that the next read/write operation must update the device's current extended FLASH address */ +bool MustLoadExtendedAddress; + + +/** ISR to manage timeouts whilst processing a V2Protocol command */ +ISR(TIMER0_COMPA_vect, ISR_NOBLOCK) +{ + if (TimeoutTicksRemaining) + TimeoutTicksRemaining--; + else + TCCR0B = 0; +} + +/** Initializes the hardware and software associated with the V2 protocol command handling. */ +void V2Protocol_Init(void) +{ + #if defined(ADC) && !defined(NO_VTARGET_DETECT) + /* Initialize the ADC converter for VTARGET level detection on supported AVR models */ + ADC_Init(ADC_FREE_RUNNING | ADC_PRESCALE_128); + ADC_SetupChannel(VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL); + ADC_StartReading(VTARGET_REF_MASK | ADC_RIGHT_ADJUSTED | VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL_MASK); + #endif + + /* Timeout timer initialization (~10ms period) */ + OCR0A = (((F_CPU / 1024) / 100) - 1); + TCCR0A = (1 << WGM01); + TIMSK0 = (1 << OCIE0A); + + V2Params_LoadNonVolatileParamValues(); + + #if defined(ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL) + ISPTarget_ConfigureRescueClock(); + #endif +} + +/** Master V2 Protocol packet handler, for received V2 Protocol packets from a connected host. + * This routine decodes the issued command and passes off the handling of the command to the + * appropriate function. + */ +void V2Protocol_ProcessCommand(void) +{ + uint8_t V2Command = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + /* Reset timeout counter duration and start the timer */ + TimeoutTicksRemaining = COMMAND_TIMEOUT_TICKS; + TCCR0B = ((1 << CS02) | (1 << CS00)); + + switch (V2Command) + { + case CMD_SIGN_ON: + V2Protocol_SignOn(); + break; + case CMD_SET_PARAMETER: + case CMD_GET_PARAMETER: + V2Protocol_GetSetParam(V2Command); + break; + case CMD_LOAD_ADDRESS: + V2Protocol_LoadAddress(); + break; + case CMD_RESET_PROTECTION: + V2Protocol_ResetProtection(); + break; +#if defined(ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL) + case CMD_ENTER_PROGMODE_ISP: + ISPProtocol_EnterISPMode(); + break; + case CMD_LEAVE_PROGMODE_ISP: + ISPProtocol_LeaveISPMode(); + break; + case CMD_PROGRAM_FLASH_ISP: + case CMD_PROGRAM_EEPROM_ISP: + ISPProtocol_ProgramMemory(V2Command); + break; + case CMD_READ_FLASH_ISP: + case CMD_READ_EEPROM_ISP: + ISPProtocol_ReadMemory(V2Command); + break; + case CMD_CHIP_ERASE_ISP: + ISPProtocol_ChipErase(); + break; + case CMD_READ_FUSE_ISP: + case CMD_READ_LOCK_ISP: + case CMD_READ_SIGNATURE_ISP: + case CMD_READ_OSCCAL_ISP: + ISPProtocol_ReadFuseLockSigOSCCAL(V2Command); + break; + case CMD_PROGRAM_FUSE_ISP: + case CMD_PROGRAM_LOCK_ISP: + ISPProtocol_WriteFuseLock(V2Command); + break; + case CMD_SPI_MULTI: + ISPProtocol_SPIMulti(); + break; +#endif +#if defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) + case CMD_XPROG_SETMODE: + XPROGProtocol_SetMode(); + break; + case CMD_XPROG: + XPROGProtocol_Command(); + break; +#endif + default: + V2Protocol_UnknownCommand(V2Command); + break; + } + + /* Disable the timeout management timer */ + TCCR0B = 0; + + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_OUT_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT); +} + +/** Handler for unknown V2 protocol commands. This discards all sent data and returns a + * STATUS_CMD_UNKNOWN status back to the host. + * + * \param[in] V2Command Issued V2 Protocol command byte from the host + */ +static void V2Protocol_UnknownCommand(const uint8_t V2Command) +{ + /* Discard all incoming data */ + while (Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint() == AVRISP_DATA_EPSIZE) + { + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + } + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + Endpoint_Write_8(V2Command); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_UNKNOWN); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_SIGN_ON command, returning the programmer ID string to the host. */ +static void V2Protocol_SignOn(void) +{ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_SIGN_ON); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + Endpoint_Write_8(sizeof(PROGRAMMER_ID) - 1); + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(PROGRAMMER_ID, (sizeof(PROGRAMMER_ID) - 1), NULL); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_RESET_PROTECTION command, implemented as a dummy ACK function as + * no target short-circuit protection is currently implemented. + */ +static void V2Protocol_ResetProtection(void) +{ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_RESET_PROTECTION); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + + +/** Handler for the CMD_SET_PARAMETER and CMD_GET_PARAMETER commands from the host, setting or + * getting a device parameter's value from the parameter table. + * + * \param[in] V2Command Issued V2 Protocol command byte from the host + */ +static void V2Protocol_GetSetParam(const uint8_t V2Command) +{ + uint8_t ParamID = Endpoint_Read_8(); + uint8_t ParamValue; + + if (V2Command == CMD_SET_PARAMETER) + ParamValue = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + Endpoint_Write_8(V2Command); + + uint8_t ParamPrivs = V2Params_GetParameterPrivileges(ParamID); + + if ((V2Command == CMD_SET_PARAMETER) && (ParamPrivs & PARAM_PRIV_WRITE)) + { + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + V2Params_SetParameterValue(ParamID, ParamValue); + } + else if ((V2Command == CMD_GET_PARAMETER) && (ParamPrivs & PARAM_PRIV_READ)) + { + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + Endpoint_Write_8(V2Params_GetParameterValue(ParamID)); + } + else + { + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_FAILED); + } + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_LOAD_ADDRESS command, loading the given device address into a + * global storage variable for later use, and issuing LOAD EXTENDED ADDRESS commands + * to the attached device as required. + */ +static void V2Protocol_LoadAddress(void) +{ + Endpoint_Read_Stream_BE(&CurrentAddress, sizeof(CurrentAddress), NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + if (CurrentAddress & (1UL << 31)) + MustLoadExtendedAddress = true; + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_LOAD_ADDRESS); + Endpoint_Write_8(STATUS_CMD_OK); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2Protocol.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2Protocol.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0f447ba4b9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2Protocol.h @@ -0,0 +1,105 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for V2Protocol.c. + */ + +#ifndef _V2_PROTOCOL_ +#define _V2_PROTOCOL_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "../AVRISPDescriptors.h" + #include "V2ProtocolConstants.h" + #include "V2ProtocolParams.h" + #include "ISP/ISPProtocol.h" + #include "XPROG/XPROGProtocol.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + #undef ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL + + #if !defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) + #define ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL + #endif + #endif + + #if defined(USB_SERIES_4_AVR) && ((VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL == 2) || (VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL == 3)) && !defined(NO_VTARGET_DETECT) + #error The U4 AVR chips do not contain ADC channels 2 or 3. Please change VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL or define NO_VTARGET_DETECT in the makefile. + #endif + + #if defined(VTARGET_USE_INTERNAL_REF) + #undef VTARGET_REF_VOLTS + #define VTARGET_REF_VOLTS 2.56 + + #define VTARGET_REF_MASK ADC_REFERENCE_INT2560MV + #else + #define VTARGET_REF_MASK ADC_REFERENCE_AVCC + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + /** Programmer ID string, returned to the host during the CMD_SIGN_ON command processing. */ + #define PROGRAMMER_ID "AVRISP_MK2" + + /** Timeout period for each issued command from the host before it is aborted (in 10ms ticks). */ + #define COMMAND_TIMEOUT_TICKS 100 + + /** Command timeout ticks remaining counter, GPIOR for speed. */ + #define TimeoutTicksRemaining GPIOR1 + + /** MUX mask for the VTARGET ADC channel number. */ + #define VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL_MASK ADC_GET_CHANNEL_MASK(VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL) + + /* External Variables: */ + extern uint32_t CurrentAddress; + extern bool MustLoadExtendedAddress; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void V2Protocol_Init(void); + void V2Protocol_ProcessCommand(void); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_V2PROTOCOL_C) + static void V2Protocol_UnknownCommand(const uint8_t V2Command); + static void V2Protocol_SignOn(void); + static void V2Protocol_GetSetParam(const uint8_t V2Command); + static void V2Protocol_ResetProtection(void); + static void V2Protocol_LoadAddress(void); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2ProtocolConstants.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2ProtocolConstants.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..121eae7f3f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2ProtocolConstants.h @@ -0,0 +1,90 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Macros for the V2 Protocol Packet Commands and Responses. + */ + +#ifndef _V2_PROTOCOL_CONSTANTS_ +#define _V2_PROTOCOL_CONSTANTS_ + + /* Macros: */ + #define CMD_SIGN_ON 0x01 + #define CMD_SET_PARAMETER 0x02 + #define CMD_GET_PARAMETER 0x03 + #define CMD_OSCCAL 0x05 + #define CMD_LOAD_ADDRESS 0x06 + #define CMD_FIRMWARE_UPGRADE 0x07 + #define CMD_RESET_PROTECTION 0x0A + #define CMD_ENTER_PROGMODE_ISP 0x10 + #define CMD_LEAVE_PROGMODE_ISP 0x11 + #define CMD_CHIP_ERASE_ISP 0x12 + #define CMD_PROGRAM_FLASH_ISP 0x13 + #define CMD_READ_FLASH_ISP 0x14 + #define CMD_PROGRAM_EEPROM_ISP 0x15 + #define CMD_READ_EEPROM_ISP 0x16 + #define CMD_PROGRAM_FUSE_ISP 0x17 + #define CMD_READ_FUSE_ISP 0x18 + #define CMD_PROGRAM_LOCK_ISP 0x19 + #define CMD_READ_LOCK_ISP 0x1A + #define CMD_READ_SIGNATURE_ISP 0x1B + #define CMD_READ_OSCCAL_ISP 0x1C + #define CMD_SPI_MULTI 0x1D + #define CMD_XPROG 0x50 + #define CMD_XPROG_SETMODE 0x51 + + #define STATUS_CMD_OK 0x00 + #define STATUS_CMD_TOUT 0x80 + #define STATUS_RDY_BSY_TOUT 0x81 + #define STATUS_SET_PARAM_MISSING 0x82 + #define STATUS_CMD_FAILED 0xC0 + #define STATUS_CMD_UNKNOWN 0xC9 + #define STATUS_CMD_ILLEGAL_PARAM 0xCA + #define STATUS_ISP_READY 0x00 + #define STATUS_CONN_FAIL_MOSI 0x01 + #define STATUS_CONN_FAIL_RST 0x02 + #define STATUS_CONN_FAIL_SCK 0x04 + #define STATUS_TGT_NOT_DETECTED 0x10 + #define STATUS_TGT_REVERSE_INSERTED 0x20 + + #define PARAM_BUILD_NUMBER_LOW 0x80 + #define PARAM_BUILD_NUMBER_HIGH 0x81 + #define PARAM_HW_VER 0x90 + #define PARAM_SW_MAJOR 0x91 + #define PARAM_SW_MINOR 0x92 + #define PARAM_VTARGET 0x94 + #define PARAM_SCK_DURATION 0x98 + #define PARAM_RESET_POLARITY 0x9E + #define PARAM_STATUS_TGT_CONN 0xA1 + #define PARAM_DISCHARGEDELAY 0xA4 + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2ProtocolParams.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2ProtocolParams.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0b33c212f8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2ProtocolParams.c @@ -0,0 +1,207 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * V2Protocol parameter handler, to process V2 Protocol device parameters. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_V2PROTOCOL_PARAMS_C +#include "V2ProtocolParams.h" + +/* Non-Volatile Parameter Values for EEPROM storage */ +static uint8_t EEMEM EEPROM_Reset_Polarity = 0x01; + +/* Non-Volatile Parameter Values for EEPROM storage */ +static uint8_t EEMEM EEPROM_SCK_Duration = 0x06; + +/* Volatile Parameter Values for RAM storage */ +static ParameterItem_t ParameterTable[] = + { + { .ParamID = PARAM_BUILD_NUMBER_LOW, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ, + .ParamValue = 0 }, + + { .ParamID = PARAM_BUILD_NUMBER_HIGH, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ, + .ParamValue = 0 }, + + { .ParamID = PARAM_HW_VER, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ, + .ParamValue = 0x00 }, + + { .ParamID = PARAM_SW_MAJOR, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ, + .ParamValue = 0x01 }, + + { .ParamID = PARAM_SW_MINOR, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ, + .ParamValue = FIRMWARE_VERSION_MINOR }, + + { .ParamID = PARAM_VTARGET, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ, + .ParamValue = (uint8_t)(3.3 * 10) }, + + { .ParamID = PARAM_SCK_DURATION, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ | PARAM_PRIV_WRITE, + .ParamValue = 6 }, + + { .ParamID = PARAM_RESET_POLARITY, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ | PARAM_PRIV_WRITE, + .ParamValue = 0x01 }, + + { .ParamID = PARAM_STATUS_TGT_CONN, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ, + .ParamValue = STATUS_ISP_READY }, + + { .ParamID = PARAM_DISCHARGEDELAY, + .ParamPrivileges = PARAM_PRIV_READ | PARAM_PRIV_WRITE, + .ParamValue = 0x00 }, + }; + + +/** Loads saved non-volatile parameter values from the EEPROM into the parameter table, as needed. */ +void V2Params_LoadNonVolatileParamValues(void) +{ + /* Read parameter values that are stored in non-volatile EEPROM */ + uint8_t ResetPolarity = eeprom_read_byte(&EEPROM_Reset_Polarity); + uint8_t SCKDuration = eeprom_read_byte(&EEPROM_SCK_Duration); + + /* Update current parameter table if the EEPROM contents was not blank */ + if (ResetPolarity != 0xFF) + V2Params_GetParamFromTable(PARAM_RESET_POLARITY)->ParamValue = ResetPolarity; + + /* Update current parameter table if the EEPROM contents was not blank */ + if (SCKDuration != 0xFF) + V2Params_GetParamFromTable(PARAM_SCK_DURATION)->ParamValue = SCKDuration; +} + +/** Updates any parameter values that are sourced from hardware rather than explicitly set by the host, such as + * VTARGET levels from the ADC on supported AVR models. + */ +void V2Params_UpdateParamValues(void) +{ + #if (defined(ADC) && !defined(NO_VTARGET_DETECT)) + /* Update VTARGET parameter with the latest ADC conversion of VTARGET on supported AVR models */ + V2Params_GetParamFromTable(PARAM_VTARGET)->ParamValue = (((uint16_t)(VTARGET_REF_VOLTS * 10 * VTARGET_SCALE_FACTOR) * ADC_GetResult()) / 1024); + #endif +} + +/** Retrieves the host PC read/write privileges for a given parameter in the parameter table. This should + * be called before calls to \ref V2Params_GetParameterValue() or \ref V2Params_SetParameterValue() when + * getting or setting parameter values in response to requests from the host. + * + * \param[in] ParamID Parameter ID whose privileges are to be retrieved from the table + * + * \return Privileges for the requested parameter, as a mask of \c PARAM_PRIV_* masks + */ +uint8_t V2Params_GetParameterPrivileges(const uint8_t ParamID) +{ + ParameterItem_t* const ParamInfo = V2Params_GetParamFromTable(ParamID); + + if (ParamInfo == NULL) + return 0; + + return ParamInfo->ParamPrivileges; +} + +/** Retrieves the current value for a given parameter in the parameter table. + * + * \note This function does not first check for read privileges - if the value is being sent to the host via a + * GET PARAM command, \ref V2Params_GetParameterPrivileges() should be called first to ensure that the + * parameter is host-readable. + * + * \param[in] ParamID Parameter ID whose value is to be retrieved from the table + * + * \return Current value of the parameter in the table, or 0 if not found + */ +uint8_t V2Params_GetParameterValue(const uint8_t ParamID) +{ + ParameterItem_t* const ParamInfo = V2Params_GetParamFromTable(ParamID); + + if (ParamInfo == NULL) + return 0; + + return ParamInfo->ParamValue; +} + +/** Sets the value for a given parameter in the parameter table. + * + * \note This function does not first check for write privileges - if the value is being sourced from the host + * via a SET PARAM command, \ref V2Params_GetParameterPrivileges() should be called first to ensure that the + * parameter is host-writable. + * + * \param[in] ParamID Parameter ID whose value is to be set in the table + * \param[in] Value New value to set the parameter to + * + * \return Pointer to the associated parameter information from the parameter table if found, NULL otherwise + */ +void V2Params_SetParameterValue(const uint8_t ParamID, + const uint8_t Value) +{ + ParameterItem_t* const ParamInfo = V2Params_GetParamFromTable(ParamID); + + if (ParamInfo == NULL) + return; + + ParamInfo->ParamValue = Value; + + /* The target RESET line polarity is a non-volatile parameter, save to EEPROM when changed */ + if (ParamID == PARAM_RESET_POLARITY) + eeprom_update_byte(&EEPROM_Reset_Polarity, Value); + + /* The target SCK line period is a non-volatile parameter, save to EEPROM when changed */ + if (ParamID == PARAM_SCK_DURATION) + eeprom_update_byte(&EEPROM_SCK_Duration, Value); +} + +/** Retrieves a parameter entry (including ID, value and privileges) from the parameter table that matches the given + * parameter ID. + * + * \param[in] ParamID Parameter ID to find in the table + * + * \return Pointer to the associated parameter information from the parameter table if found, NULL otherwise + */ +static ParameterItem_t* const V2Params_GetParamFromTable(const uint8_t ParamID) +{ + ParameterItem_t* CurrTableItem = ParameterTable; + + /* Find the parameter in the parameter table if present */ + for (uint8_t TableIndex = 0; TableIndex < TABLE_PARAM_COUNT; TableIndex++) + { + if (ParamID == CurrTableItem->ParamID) + return CurrTableItem; + + CurrTableItem++; + } + + return NULL; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2ProtocolParams.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2ProtocolParams.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b195f67c55 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/V2ProtocolParams.h @@ -0,0 +1,91 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for V2ProtocolParams.c. + */ + +#ifndef _V2_PROTOCOL_PARAMS_ +#define _V2_PROTOCOL_PARAMS_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/eeprom.h> + + #if defined(ADC) + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/ADC.h> + #endif + + #include "V2Protocol.h" + #include "V2ProtocolConstants.h" + #include "ISP/ISPTarget.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Parameter privilege mask to allow the host PC to read the parameter's value. */ + #define PARAM_PRIV_READ (1 << 0) + + /** Parameter privilege mask to allow the host PC to change the parameter's value. */ + #define PARAM_PRIV_WRITE (1 << 1) + + /** Total number of parameters in the parameter table */ + #define TABLE_PARAM_COUNT (sizeof(ParameterTable) / sizeof(ParameterTable[0])) + + #if (!defined(FIRMWARE_VERSION_MINOR) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)) + /** Minor firmware version, reported to the host on request; must match the version + * the host is expecting, or it (may) reject further communications with the programmer. */ + #define FIRMWARE_VERSION_MINOR 0x18 + #endif + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a parameter table entry indicating a PC readable or writable device parameter. */ + typedef struct + { + const uint8_t ParamID; /**< Parameter ID number to uniquely identify the parameter within the device */ + const uint8_t ParamPrivileges; /**< Parameter privileges to allow the host to read or write the parameter's value */ + uint8_t ParamValue; /**< Current parameter's value within the device */ + } ParameterItem_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void V2Params_LoadNonVolatileParamValues(void); + void V2Params_UpdateParamValues(void); + + uint8_t V2Params_GetParameterPrivileges(const uint8_t ParamID); + uint8_t V2Params_GetParameterValue(const uint8_t ParamID); + void V2Params_SetParameterValue(const uint8_t ParamID, + const uint8_t Value); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_V2PROTOCOL_PARAMS_C) + static ParameterItem_t* const V2Params_GetParamFromTable(const uint8_t ParamID); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/TINYNVM.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/TINYNVM.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..22eb7d74cb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/TINYNVM.c @@ -0,0 +1,274 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Target-related functions for the TINY target's NVM module. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_TINYNVM_C +#include "TINYNVM.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + +/** Sends the given pointer address to the target's TPI pointer register */ +static void TINYNVM_SendPointerAddress(const uint16_t AbsoluteAddress) +{ + /* Send the given 16-bit address to the target, LSB first */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SSTPR | 0); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(AbsoluteAddress & 0xFF); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SSTPR | 1); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(AbsoluteAddress >> 8); +} + +/** Sends a SIN command to the target with the specified I/O address, ready for the data byte to be written. + * + * \param[in] Address 6-bit I/O address to write to in the target's I/O memory space + */ +static void TINYNVM_SendReadNVMRegister(const uint8_t Address) +{ + /* The TPI command for reading from the I/O space uses strange addressing, where the I/O address's upper + * two bits of the 6-bit address are shifted left once - use function to reduce code size */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SIN(Address)); +} + +/** Sends a SOUT command to the target with the specified I/O address, ready for the data byte to be read. + * + * \param[in] Address 6-bit I/O address to read from in the target's I/O memory space + */ +static void TINYNVM_SendWriteNVMRegister(const uint8_t Address) +{ + /* The TPI command for reading from the I/O space uses strange addressing, where the I/O address's upper + * two bits of the 6-bit address are shifted left once - use function to reduce code size */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SOUT(Address)); +} + +/** Busy-waits while the NVM controller is busy performing a NVM operation, such as a FLASH page read. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the NVM controller became ready within the timeout period, \c false otherwise + */ +bool TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy(void) +{ + /* Poll the STATUS register to check to see if NVM access has been enabled */ + for (;;) + { + /* Send the SLDCS command to read the TPI STATUS register to see the NVM bus is active */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SLDCS(TPI_REG_STATUS)); + + uint8_t StatusRegister = XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(); + + /* We might have timed out waiting for the status register read response, check here */ + if (!(TimeoutTicksRemaining)) + return false; + + /* Check the status register read response to see if the NVM bus is enabled */ + if (StatusRegister & TPI_STATUS_NVM) + return true; + } +} + +/** Waits while the target's NVM controller is busy performing an operation, exiting if the + * timeout period expires. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the NVM controller became ready within the timeout period, \c false otherwise + */ +bool TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy(void) +{ + /* Poll the STATUS register to check to see if NVM access has been enabled */ + for (;;) + { + /* Send the SIN command to read the TPI STATUS register to see the NVM bus is busy */ + TINYNVM_SendReadNVMRegister(XPROG_Param_NVMCSRRegAddr); + + uint8_t StatusRegister = XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(); + + /* We might have timed out waiting for the status register read response, check here */ + if (!(TimeoutTicksRemaining)) + return false; + + /* Check to see if the BUSY flag is still set */ + if (!(StatusRegister & (1 << 7))) + return true; + } +} + +/** Enables the physical TPI interface on the target and enables access to the internal NVM controller. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the TPI interface was enabled successfully, \c false otherwise + */ +bool TINYNVM_EnableTPI(void) +{ + /* Enable TPI programming mode with the attached target */ + XPROGTarget_EnableTargetTPI(); + + /* Lower direction change guard time to 32 USART bits */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SSTCS(TPI_REG_CTRL)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(0x02); + + /* Enable access to the XPROG NVM bus by sending the documented NVM access key to the device */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SKEY); + for (uint8_t i = sizeof(TPI_NVMENABLE_KEY); i > 0; i--) + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_NVMENABLE_KEY[i - 1]); + + /* Wait until the NVM bus becomes active */ + return TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy(); +} + +/** Removes access to the target's NVM controller and physically disables the target's physical TPI interface. */ +void TINYNVM_DisableTPI(void) +{ + TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy(); + + do + { + /* Clear the NVMEN bit in the TPI STATUS register to disable TPI mode */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SSTCS(TPI_REG_STATUS)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(0x00); + + /* Read back the STATUS register, check to see if it took effect */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SLDCS(TPI_REG_STATUS)); + } while (XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte() != 0x00); + + XPROGTarget_DisableTargetTPI(); +} + +/** Reads memory from the target's memory spaces. + * + * \param[in] ReadAddress Start address to read from within the target's address space + * \param[out] ReadBuffer Buffer to store read data into + * \param[in] ReadSize Length of the data to read from the device + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command sequence complete successfully + */ +bool TINYNVM_ReadMemory(const uint16_t ReadAddress, + uint8_t* ReadBuffer, + uint16_t ReadSize) +{ + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Set the NVM control register to the NO OP command for memory reading */ + TINYNVM_SendWriteNVMRegister(XPROG_Param_NVMCMDRegAddr); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TINY_NVM_CMD_NOOP); + + /* Send the address of the location to read from */ + TINYNVM_SendPointerAddress(ReadAddress); + + while (ReadSize-- && TimeoutTicksRemaining) + { + /* Read the byte of data from the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SLD(TPI_POINTER_INDIRECT_PI)); + *(ReadBuffer++) = XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(); + } + + return (TimeoutTicksRemaining > 0); +} + +/** Writes word addressed memory to the target's memory spaces. + * + * \param[in] WriteAddress Start address to write to within the target's address space + * \param[in] WriteBuffer Buffer to source data from + * \param[in] WriteLength Total number of bytes to write to the device (must be an integer multiple of 2) + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command sequence complete successfully + */ +bool TINYNVM_WriteMemory(const uint16_t WriteAddress, + uint8_t* WriteBuffer, + uint16_t WriteLength) +{ + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Must have an integer number of words to write - if extra byte, word-align via a dummy high byte */ + if (WriteLength & 0x01) + WriteBuffer[WriteLength++] = 0xFF; + + /* Set the NVM control register to the WORD WRITE command for memory writing */ + TINYNVM_SendWriteNVMRegister(XPROG_Param_NVMCMDRegAddr); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TINY_NVM_CMD_WORDWRITE); + + /* Send the address of the location to write to */ + TINYNVM_SendPointerAddress(WriteAddress); + + while (WriteLength) + { + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Write the low byte of data to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SST(TPI_POINTER_INDIRECT_PI)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(*(WriteBuffer++)); + + /* Write the high byte of data to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SST(TPI_POINTER_INDIRECT_PI)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(*(WriteBuffer++)); + + /* Need to decrement the write length twice, since we wrote a whole two-byte word */ + WriteLength -= 2; + } + + return true; +} + +/** Erases the target's memory space. + * + * \param[in] EraseCommand NVM erase command to send to the device + * \param[in] Address Address inside the memory space to erase + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command sequence complete successfully + */ +bool TINYNVM_EraseMemory(const uint8_t EraseCommand, + const uint16_t Address) +{ + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Set the NVM control register to the target memory erase command */ + TINYNVM_SendWriteNVMRegister(XPROG_Param_NVMCMDRegAddr); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(EraseCommand); + + /* Write to a high byte location within the target address space to start the erase process */ + TINYNVM_SendPointerAddress(Address | 0x0001); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(TPI_CMD_SST(TPI_POINTER_INDIRECT)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(0x00); + + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + return true; +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/TINYNVM.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/TINYNVM.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..61389bb455 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/TINYNVM.h @@ -0,0 +1,86 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for TINYNVM.c. + */ + +#ifndef _TINY_NVM_ +#define _TINY_NVM_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + + #include "XPROGProtocol.h" + #include "XPROGTarget.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + #undef ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL + + #if !defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) + #define ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL + #endif + #endif + + /* Defines: */ + #define TINY_NVM_CMD_NOOP 0x00 + #define TINY_NVM_CMD_CHIPERASE 0x10 + #define TINY_NVM_CMD_SECTIONERASE 0x14 + #define TINY_NVM_CMD_WORDWRITE 0x1D + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + bool TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy(void); + bool TINYNVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy(void); + bool TINYNVM_EnableTPI(void); + void TINYNVM_DisableTPI(void); + bool TINYNVM_ReadMemory(const uint16_t ReadAddress, + uint8_t* ReadBuffer, + uint16_t ReadLength); + bool TINYNVM_WriteMemory(const uint16_t WriteAddress, + uint8_t* WriteBuffer, + uint16_t WriteLength); + bool TINYNVM_EraseMemory(const uint8_t EraseCommand, + const uint16_t Address); + + #if (defined(INCLUDE_FROM_TINYNVM_C) && defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL)) + static void TINYNVM_SendReadNVMRegister(const uint8_t Address); + static void TINYNVM_SendWriteNVMRegister(const uint8_t Address); + static void TINYNVM_SendPointerAddress(const uint16_t AbsoluteAddress); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XMEGANVM.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XMEGANVM.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0208a634b7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XMEGANVM.c @@ -0,0 +1,468 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Target-related functions for the XMEGA target's NVM module. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_XMEGA_NVM_C +#include "XMEGANVM.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + +/** Sends the given 32-bit absolute address to the target. + * + * \param[in] AbsoluteAddress Absolute address to send to the target + */ +static void XMEGANVM_SendAddress(const uint32_t AbsoluteAddress) +{ + /* Send the given 32-bit address to the target, LSB first */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(AbsoluteAddress & 0xFF); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(AbsoluteAddress >> 8); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(AbsoluteAddress >> 16); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(AbsoluteAddress >> 24); +} + +/** Sends the given NVM register address to the target. + * + * \param[in] Register NVM register whose absolute address is to be sent + */ +static void XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(const uint8_t Register) +{ + /* Determine the absolute register address from the NVM base memory address and the NVM register address */ + uint32_t Address = XPROG_Param_NVMBase | Register; + + /* Send the calculated 32-bit address to the target, LSB first */ + XMEGANVM_SendAddress(Address); +} + +/** Busy-waits while the NVM controller is busy performing a NVM operation, such as a FLASH page read or CRC + * calculation. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the NVM controller became ready within the timeout period, \c false otherwise + */ +bool XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy(void) +{ + /* Poll the STATUS register to check to see if NVM access has been enabled */ + for (;;) + { + /* Send the LDCS command to read the PDI STATUS register to see the NVM bus is active */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_LDCS(PDI_REG_STATUS)); + + uint8_t StatusRegister = XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(); + + /* We might have timed out waiting for the status register read response, check here */ + if (!(TimeoutTicksRemaining)) + return false; + + /* Check the status register read response to see if the NVM bus is enabled */ + if (StatusRegister & PDI_STATUS_NVM) + return true; + } +} + +/** Waits while the target's NVM controller is busy performing an operation, exiting if the + * timeout period expires. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the NVM controller became ready within the timeout period, \c false otherwise + */ +bool XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy(void) +{ + /* Preload the pointer register with the NVM STATUS register address to check the BUSY flag */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_ST(PDI_POINTER_DIRECT, PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_STATUS); + + /* Poll the NVM STATUS register while the NVM controller is busy */ + for (;;) + { + /* Fetch the current status value via the pointer register (without auto-increment afterwards) */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_LD(PDI_POINTER_INDIRECT, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + + uint8_t StatusRegister = XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(); + + /* We might have timed out waiting for the status register read response, check here */ + if (!(TimeoutTicksRemaining)) + return false; + + /* Check to see if the BUSY flag is still set */ + if (!(StatusRegister & (1 << 7))) + return true; + } +} + +/** Enables the physical PDI interface on the target and enables access to the internal NVM controller. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the PDI interface was enabled successfully, \c false otherwise + */ +bool XMEGANVM_EnablePDI(void) +{ + /* Enable PDI programming mode with the attached target */ + XPROGTarget_EnableTargetPDI(); + + /* Store the RESET key into the RESET PDI register to keep the XMEGA in reset */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STCS(PDI_REG_RESET)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_RESET_KEY); + + /* Lower direction change guard time to 32 USART bits */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STCS(PDI_REG_CTRL)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(0x02); + + /* Enable access to the XPROG NVM bus by sending the documented NVM access key to the device */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_KEY); + for (uint8_t i = sizeof(PDI_NVMENABLE_KEY); i > 0; i--) + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_NVMENABLE_KEY[i - 1]); + + /* Wait until the NVM bus becomes active */ + return XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy(); +} + +/** Removes access to the target's NVM controller and physically disables the target's physical PDI interface. */ +void XMEGANVM_DisablePDI(void) +{ + XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy(); + + /* Clear the RESET key in the RESET PDI register to allow the XMEGA to run - must perform this until the + * change takes effect, as in some cases it takes multiple writes (silicon bug?). + */ + do + { + /* Clear reset register */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STCS(PDI_REG_RESET)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(0x00); + + /* Read back the reset register, check to see if it took effect */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_LDCS(PDI_REG_RESET)); + } while (XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte() != 0x00); + + XPROGTarget_DisableTargetPDI(); +} + +/** Retrieves the CRC value of the given memory space. + * + * \param[in] CRCCommand NVM CRC command to issue to the target + * \param[out] CRCDest CRC Destination when read from the target + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command sequence complete successfully + */ +bool XMEGANVM_GetMemoryCRC(const uint8_t CRCCommand, + uint32_t* const CRCDest) +{ + *CRCDest = 0; + + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Set the NVM command to the correct CRC read command */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(CRCCommand); + + /* Set CMDEX bit in NVM CTRLA register to start the CRC generation */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CTRLA); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XMEGA_NVM_BIT_CTRLA_CMDEX); + + /* Wait until the NVM bus is ready again */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy())) + return false; + + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Load the PDI pointer register with the DAT0 register start address */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_ST(PDI_POINTER_DIRECT, PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_DAT0); + + /* Send the REPEAT command to grab the CRC bytes */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_REPEAT(PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XMEGA_CRC_LENGTH_BYTES - 1); + + /* Read in the CRC bytes from the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_LD(PDI_POINTER_INDIRECT_PI, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < XMEGA_CRC_LENGTH_BYTES; i++) + ((uint8_t*)CRCDest)[i] = XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(); + + return (TimeoutTicksRemaining > 0); +} + +/** Reads memory from the target's memory spaces. + * + * \param[in] ReadAddress Start address to read from within the target's address space + * \param[out] ReadBuffer Buffer to store read data into + * \param[in] ReadSize Number of bytes to read + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command sequence complete successfully + */ +bool XMEGANVM_ReadMemory(const uint32_t ReadAddress, + uint8_t* ReadBuffer, + uint16_t ReadSize) +{ + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Send the READNVM command to the NVM controller for reading of an arbitrary location */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XMEGA_NVM_CMD_READNVM); + + if (ReadSize > 1) + { + /* Load the PDI pointer register with the start address we want to read from */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_ST(PDI_POINTER_DIRECT, PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES)); + XMEGANVM_SendAddress(ReadAddress); + + /* Send the REPEAT command with the specified number of bytes to read */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_REPEAT(PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(ReadSize - 1); + + /* Send a LD command with indirect access and post-increment to read out the bytes */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_LD(PDI_POINTER_INDIRECT_PI, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + while (ReadSize-- && TimeoutTicksRemaining) + *(ReadBuffer++) = XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(); + } + else + { + /* Send a LDS command with the read address to read out the requested byte */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_LDS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendAddress(ReadAddress); + *(ReadBuffer++) = XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(); + } + + return (TimeoutTicksRemaining > 0); +} + +/** Writes byte addressed memory to the target's memory spaces. + * + * \param[in] WriteCommand Command to send to the device to write each memory byte + * \param[in] WriteAddress Address to write to within the target's address space + * \param[in] Byte Byte to write to the target + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command sequence complete successfully + */ +bool XMEGANVM_WriteByteMemory(const uint8_t WriteCommand, + const uint32_t WriteAddress, + const uint8_t Byte) +{ + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Send the memory write command to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(WriteCommand); + + /* Send new memory byte to the memory of the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendAddress(WriteAddress); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(Byte); + + return true; +} + +/** Writes page addressed memory to the target's memory spaces. + * + * \param[in] WriteBuffCommand Command to send to the device to write a byte to the memory page buffer + * \param[in] EraseBuffCommand Command to send to the device to erase the memory page buffer + * \param[in] WritePageCommand Command to send to the device to write the page buffer to the destination memory + * \param[in] PageMode Bitfield indicating what operations need to be executed on the specified page + * \param[in] WriteAddress Start address to write the page data to within the target's address space + * \param[in] WriteBuffer Buffer to source data from + * \param[in] WriteSize Number of bytes to write + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command sequence complete successfully + */ +bool XMEGANVM_WritePageMemory(const uint8_t WriteBuffCommand, + const uint8_t EraseBuffCommand, + const uint8_t WritePageCommand, + const uint8_t PageMode, + const uint32_t WriteAddress, + const uint8_t* WriteBuffer, + uint16_t WriteSize) +{ + if (PageMode & XPROG_PAGEMODE_ERASE) + { + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Send the memory buffer erase command to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(EraseBuffCommand); + + /* Set CMDEX bit in NVM CTRLA register to start the buffer erase */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CTRLA); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XMEGA_NVM_BIT_CTRLA_CMDEX); + } + + if (WriteSize) + { + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Send the memory buffer write command to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(WriteBuffCommand); + + /* Load the PDI pointer register with the start address we want to write to */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_ST(PDI_POINTER_DIRECT, PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES)); + XMEGANVM_SendAddress(WriteAddress); + + /* Send the REPEAT command with the specified number of bytes to write */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_REPEAT(PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(WriteSize - 1); + + /* Send a ST command with indirect access and post-increment to write the bytes */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_ST(PDI_POINTER_INDIRECT_PI, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + while (WriteSize--) + XPROGTarget_SendByte(*(WriteBuffer++)); + } + + if (PageMode & XPROG_PAGEMODE_WRITE) + { + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Send the memory write command to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(WritePageCommand); + + /* Send the address of the first page location to write the memory page */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendAddress(WriteAddress); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(0x00); + } + + return true; +} + +/** Erases a specific memory space of the target. + * + * \param[in] EraseCommand NVM erase command to send to the device + * \param[in] Address Address inside the memory space to erase + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command sequence complete successfully + */ +bool XMEGANVM_EraseMemory(const uint8_t EraseCommand, + const uint32_t Address) +{ + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* EEPROM and Chip erasures are triggered differently to FLASH section erasures */ + if (EraseCommand == XMEGA_NVM_CMD_CHIPERASE) + { + /* Send the memory erase command to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(EraseCommand); + + /* Set CMDEX bit in NVM CTRLA register to start the erase sequence */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CTRLA); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XMEGA_NVM_BIT_CTRLA_CMDEX); + } + else if (EraseCommand == XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEEEPROM) + { + /* Send the EEPROM page buffer erase command to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEEEPROMPAGEBUFF); + + /* Set CMDEX bit in NVM CTRLA register to start the buffer erase */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CTRLA); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XMEGA_NVM_BIT_CTRLA_CMDEX); + + /* Wait until the NVM controller is no longer busy */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy())) + return false; + + /* Send the EEPROM memory buffer write command to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XMEGA_NVM_CMD_LOADEEPROMPAGEBUFF); + + /* Load the PDI pointer register with the EEPROM page start address */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_ST(PDI_POINTER_DIRECT, PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES)); + XMEGANVM_SendAddress(Address); + + /* Send the REPEAT command with the specified number of bytes to write */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_REPEAT(PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XPROG_Param_EEPageSize - 1); + + /* Send a ST command with indirect access and post-increment to tag each byte in the EEPROM page buffer */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_ST(PDI_POINTER_INDIRECT_PI, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + for (uint8_t PageByte = 0; PageByte < XPROG_Param_EEPageSize; PageByte++) + XPROGTarget_SendByte(0x00); + + /* Send the memory erase command to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(EraseCommand); + + /* Set CMDEX bit in NVM CTRLA register to start the EEPROM erase sequence */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CTRLA); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(XMEGA_NVM_BIT_CTRLA_CMDEX); + } + else + { + /* Send the memory erase command to the target */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(EraseCommand); + + /* Other erase modes just need us to address a byte within the target memory space */ + XPROGTarget_SendByte(PDI_CMD_STS(PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES, PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE)); + XMEGANVM_SendAddress(Address); + XPROGTarget_SendByte(0x00); + } + + /* Wait until the NVM bus is ready again */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy())) + return false; + + return true; +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XMEGANVM.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XMEGANVM.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8a8c5b048a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XMEGANVM.h @@ -0,0 +1,140 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for XMEGANVM.c. + */ + +#ifndef _XMEGA_NVM_ +#define _XMEGA_NVM_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + + #include "XPROGProtocol.h" + #include "XPROGTarget.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + #undef ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL + + #if !defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) + #define ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL + #endif + #endif + + /* Defines: */ + #define XMEGA_CRC_LENGTH_BYTES 3 + + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_ADDR0 0x00 + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_ADDR1 0x01 + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_ADDR2 0x02 + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_DAT0 0x04 + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_DAT1 0x05 + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_DAT2 0x06 + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_CMD 0x0A + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_CTRLA 0x0B + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_CTRLB 0x0C + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_INTCTRL 0x0D + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_STATUS 0x0F + #define XMEGA_NVM_REG_LOCKBITS 0x10 + + #define XMEGA_NVM_BIT_CTRLA_CMDEX (1 << 0) + + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_NOOP 0x00 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_CHIPERASE 0x40 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_READNVM 0x43 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_LOADFLASHPAGEBUFF 0x23 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEFLASHPAGEBUFF 0x26 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEFLASHPAGE 0x2B + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEFLASHPAGE 0x2E + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEWRITEFLASH 0x2F + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_FLASHCRC 0x78 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEAPPSEC 0x20 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEAPPSECPAGE 0x22 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEAPPSECPAGE 0x24 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEWRITEAPPSECPAGE 0x25 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_APPCRC 0x38 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEBOOTSEC 0x68 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEBOOTSECPAGE 0x2A + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEBOOTSECPAGE 0x2C + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEWRITEBOOTSECPAGE 0x2D + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_BOOTCRC 0x39 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_READUSERSIG 0x03 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEUSERSIG 0x18 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEUSERSIG 0x1A + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_READCALIBRATION 0x02 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_READFUSE 0x07 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEFUSE 0x4C + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITELOCK 0x08 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_LOADEEPROMPAGEBUFF 0x33 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEEEPROMPAGEBUFF 0x36 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEEEPROM 0x30 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEEEPROMPAGE 0x32 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEEEPROMPAGE 0x34 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEWRITEEEPROMPAGE 0x35 + #define XMEGA_NVM_CMD_READEEPROM 0x06 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + bool XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy(void); + bool XMEGANVM_WaitWhileNVMControllerBusy(void); + bool XMEGANVM_EnablePDI(void); + void XMEGANVM_DisablePDI(void); + bool XMEGANVM_GetMemoryCRC(const uint8_t CRCCommand, + uint32_t* const CRCDest); + bool XMEGANVM_ReadMemory(const uint32_t ReadAddress, + uint8_t* ReadBuffer, + uint16_t ReadSize); + bool XMEGANVM_WriteByteMemory(const uint8_t WriteCommand, + const uint32_t WriteAddress, + const uint8_t Byte); + bool XMEGANVM_WritePageMemory(const uint8_t WriteBuffCommand, + const uint8_t EraseBuffCommand, + const uint8_t WritePageCommand, + const uint8_t PageMode, + const uint32_t WriteAddress, + const uint8_t* WriteBuffer, + uint16_t WriteSize); + bool XMEGANVM_EraseMemory(const uint8_t EraseCommand, + const uint32_t Address); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_XMEGANVM_C) + static void XMEGANVM_SendNVMRegAddress(const uint8_t Register); + static void XMEGANVM_SendAddress(const uint32_t AbsoluteAddress); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGProtocol.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGProtocol.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..aa5503f3ff --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGProtocol.c @@ -0,0 +1,480 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * XPROG Protocol handler, to process V2 Protocol wrapped XPROG commands used in Atmel programmer devices. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_XPROGPROTOCOL_C +#include "XPROGProtocol.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) +/** Base absolute address for the target's NVM controller for PDI programming */ +uint32_t XPROG_Param_NVMBase = 0x010001C0; + +/** Size in bytes of the target's EEPROM page */ +uint16_t XPROG_Param_EEPageSize = 32; + +/** Address of the TPI device's NVMCMD register for TPI programming */ +uint8_t XPROG_Param_NVMCMDRegAddr = 0x33; + +/** Address of the TPI device's NVMCSR register for TPI programming */ +uint8_t XPROG_Param_NVMCSRRegAddr = 0x32; + +/** Currently selected XPROG programming protocol */ +uint8_t XPROG_SelectedProtocol = XPROG_PROTOCOL_PDI; + +/** Handler for the CMD_XPROG_SETMODE command, which sets the programmer-to-target protocol used for PDI/TPI + * programming. + */ +void XPROGProtocol_SetMode(void) +{ + struct + { + uint8_t Protocol; + } SetMode_XPROG_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&SetMode_XPROG_Params, sizeof(SetMode_XPROG_Params), NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + XPROG_SelectedProtocol = SetMode_XPROG_Params.Protocol; + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_XPROG_SETMODE); + Endpoint_Write_8((SetMode_XPROG_Params.Protocol != XPROG_PROTOCOL_JTAG) ? STATUS_CMD_OK : STATUS_CMD_FAILED); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the CMD_XPROG command, which wraps up XPROG commands in a V2 wrapper which need to be + * removed and processed so that the underlying XPROG command can be handled. + */ +void XPROGProtocol_Command(void) +{ + uint8_t XPROGCommand = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + switch (XPROGCommand) + { + case XPROG_CMD_ENTER_PROGMODE: + XPROGProtocol_EnterXPROGMode(); + break; + case XPROG_CMD_LEAVE_PROGMODE: + XPROGProtocol_LeaveXPROGMode(); + break; + case XPROG_CMD_ERASE: + XPROGProtocol_Erase(); + break; + case XPROG_CMD_WRITE_MEM: + XPROGProtocol_WriteMemory(); + break; + case XPROG_CMD_READ_MEM: + XPROGProtocol_ReadMemory(); + break; + case XPROG_CMD_CRC: + XPROGProtocol_ReadCRC(); + break; + case XPROG_CMD_SET_PARAM: + XPROGProtocol_SetParam(); + break; + } +} + +/** Handler for the XPROG ENTER_PROGMODE command to establish a connection with the attached device. */ +static void XPROGProtocol_EnterXPROGMode(void) +{ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + bool NVMBusEnabled = false; + + if (XPROG_SelectedProtocol == XPROG_PROTOCOL_PDI) + NVMBusEnabled = XMEGANVM_EnablePDI(); + else if (XPROG_SelectedProtocol == XPROG_PROTOCOL_TPI) + NVMBusEnabled = TINYNVM_EnableTPI(); + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_XPROG); + Endpoint_Write_8(XPROG_CMD_ENTER_PROGMODE); + Endpoint_Write_8(NVMBusEnabled ? XPROG_ERR_OK : XPROG_ERR_FAILED); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the XPROG LEAVE_PROGMODE command to terminate the PDI programming connection with + * the attached device. + */ +static void XPROGProtocol_LeaveXPROGMode(void) +{ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + if (XPROG_SelectedProtocol == XPROG_PROTOCOL_PDI) + XMEGANVM_DisablePDI(); + else + TINYNVM_DisableTPI(); + + #if defined(XCK_RESCUE_CLOCK_ENABLE) && defined(ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL) + /* If the XCK rescue clock option is enabled, we need to restart it once the + * XPROG mode has been exited, since the XPROG protocol stops it after use. */ + ISPTarget_ConfigureRescueClock(); + #endif + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_XPROG); + Endpoint_Write_8(XPROG_CMD_LEAVE_PROGMODE); + Endpoint_Write_8(XPROG_ERR_OK); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the XPRG ERASE command to erase a specific memory address space in the attached device. */ +static void XPROGProtocol_Erase(void) +{ + uint8_t ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_OK; + + struct + { + uint8_t MemoryType; + uint32_t Address; + } Erase_XPROG_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&Erase_XPROG_Params, sizeof(Erase_XPROG_Params), NULL); + Erase_XPROG_Params.Address = SwapEndian_32(Erase_XPROG_Params.Address); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + uint8_t EraseCommand; + + if (XPROG_SelectedProtocol == XPROG_PROTOCOL_PDI) + { + /* Determine which NVM command to send to the device depending on the memory to erase */ + switch (Erase_XPROG_Params.MemoryType) + { + case XPROG_ERASE_CHIP: + EraseCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_CHIPERASE; + break; + case XPROG_ERASE_APP: + EraseCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEAPPSEC; + break; + case XPROG_ERASE_BOOT: + EraseCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEBOOTSEC; + break; + case XPROG_ERASE_EEPROM: + EraseCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEEEPROM; + break; + case XPROG_ERASE_APP_PAGE: + EraseCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEAPPSECPAGE; + break; + case XPROG_ERASE_BOOT_PAGE: + EraseCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEBOOTSECPAGE; + break; + case XPROG_ERASE_EEPROM_PAGE: + EraseCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEEEPROMPAGE; + break; + case XPROG_ERASE_USERSIG: + EraseCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEUSERSIG; + break; + default: + EraseCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_NOOP; + break; + } + + /* Erase the target memory, indicate timeout if occurred */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_EraseMemory(EraseCommand, Erase_XPROG_Params.Address))) + ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_TIMEOUT; + } + else + { + if (Erase_XPROG_Params.MemoryType == XPROG_ERASE_CHIP) + EraseCommand = TINY_NVM_CMD_CHIPERASE; + else + EraseCommand = TINY_NVM_CMD_SECTIONERASE; + + /* Erase the target memory, indicate timeout if occurred */ + if (!(TINYNVM_EraseMemory(EraseCommand, Erase_XPROG_Params.Address))) + ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_TIMEOUT; + } + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_XPROG); + Endpoint_Write_8(XPROG_CMD_ERASE); + Endpoint_Write_8(ReturnStatus); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the XPROG WRITE_MEMORY command to write to a specific memory space within the attached device. */ +static void XPROGProtocol_WriteMemory(void) +{ + uint8_t ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_OK; + + struct + { + uint8_t MemoryType; + uint8_t PageMode; + uint32_t Address; + uint16_t Length; + uint8_t ProgData[256]; + } WriteMemory_XPROG_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&WriteMemory_XPROG_Params, (sizeof(WriteMemory_XPROG_Params) - + sizeof(WriteMemory_XPROG_Params).ProgData), NULL); + WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Address = SwapEndian_32(WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Address); + WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Length = SwapEndian_16(WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Length); + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.ProgData, WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Length, NULL); + + // The driver will terminate transfers that are a round multiple of the endpoint bank in size with a ZLP, need + // to catch this and discard it before continuing on with packet processing to prevent communication issues + if (((sizeof(uint8_t) + sizeof(WriteMemory_XPROG_Params) - sizeof(WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.ProgData)) + + WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Length) % AVRISP_DATA_EPSIZE == 0) + { + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_WaitUntilReady(); + } + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + if (XPROG_SelectedProtocol == XPROG_PROTOCOL_PDI) + { + /* Assume FLASH page programming by default, as it is the common case */ + uint8_t WriteCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEFLASHPAGE; + uint8_t WriteBuffCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_LOADFLASHPAGEBUFF; + uint8_t EraseBuffCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEFLASHPAGEBUFF; + bool PagedMemory = true; + + switch (WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.MemoryType) + { + case XPROG_MEM_TYPE_APPL: + WriteCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEAPPSECPAGE; + break; + case XPROG_MEM_TYPE_BOOT: + WriteCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEBOOTSECPAGE; + break; + case XPROG_MEM_TYPE_EEPROM: + WriteCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEWRITEEEPROMPAGE; + WriteBuffCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_LOADEEPROMPAGEBUFF; + EraseBuffCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_ERASEEEPROMPAGEBUFF; + break; + case XPROG_MEM_TYPE_USERSIG: + WriteCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEUSERSIG; + break; + case XPROG_MEM_TYPE_FUSE: + WriteCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITEFUSE; + PagedMemory = false; + break; + case XPROG_MEM_TYPE_LOCKBITS: + WriteCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_WRITELOCK; + PagedMemory = false; + break; + } + + /* Send the appropriate memory write commands to the device, indicate timeout if occurred */ + if ((PagedMemory && !(XMEGANVM_WritePageMemory(WriteBuffCommand, EraseBuffCommand, WriteCommand, + WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.PageMode, WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Address, + WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.ProgData, WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Length))) || + (!PagedMemory && !(XMEGANVM_WriteByteMemory(WriteCommand, WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Address, + WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.ProgData[0])))) + { + ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_TIMEOUT; + } + } + else + { + /* Send write command to the TPI device, indicate timeout if occurred */ + if (!(TINYNVM_WriteMemory(WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Address, WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.ProgData, + WriteMemory_XPROG_Params.Length))) + { + ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_TIMEOUT; + } + } + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_XPROG); + Endpoint_Write_8(XPROG_CMD_WRITE_MEM); + Endpoint_Write_8(ReturnStatus); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the XPROG READ_MEMORY command to read data from a specific address space within the + * attached device. + */ +static void XPROGProtocol_ReadMemory(void) +{ + uint8_t ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_OK; + + struct + { + uint8_t MemoryType; + uint32_t Address; + uint16_t Length; + } ReadMemory_XPROG_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&ReadMemory_XPROG_Params, sizeof(ReadMemory_XPROG_Params), NULL); + ReadMemory_XPROG_Params.Address = SwapEndian_32(ReadMemory_XPROG_Params.Address); + ReadMemory_XPROG_Params.Length = SwapEndian_16(ReadMemory_XPROG_Params.Length); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + uint8_t ReadBuffer[256]; + + if (XPROG_SelectedProtocol == XPROG_PROTOCOL_PDI) + { + /* Read the PDI target's memory, indicate timeout if occurred */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_ReadMemory(ReadMemory_XPROG_Params.Address, ReadBuffer, ReadMemory_XPROG_Params.Length))) + ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_TIMEOUT; + } + else + { + /* Read the TPI target's memory, indicate timeout if occurred */ + if (!(TINYNVM_ReadMemory(ReadMemory_XPROG_Params.Address, ReadBuffer, ReadMemory_XPROG_Params.Length))) + ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_TIMEOUT; + } + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_XPROG); + Endpoint_Write_8(XPROG_CMD_READ_MEM); + Endpoint_Write_8(ReturnStatus); + + if (ReturnStatus == XPROG_ERR_OK) + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(ReadBuffer, ReadMemory_XPROG_Params.Length, NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the XPROG CRC command to read a specific memory space's CRC value for comparison between the + * attached device's memory and a data set on the host. + */ +static void XPROGProtocol_ReadCRC(void) +{ + uint8_t ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_OK; + + struct + { + uint8_t CRCType; + } ReadCRC_XPROG_Params; + + Endpoint_Read_Stream_LE(&ReadCRC_XPROG_Params, sizeof(ReadCRC_XPROG_Params), NULL); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + uint32_t MemoryCRC; + + if (XPROG_SelectedProtocol == XPROG_PROTOCOL_PDI) + { + uint8_t CRCCommand; + + /* Determine which NVM command to send to the device depending on the memory to CRC */ + switch (ReadCRC_XPROG_Params.CRCType) + { + case XPROG_CRC_APP: + CRCCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_APPCRC; + break; + case XPROG_CRC_BOOT: + CRCCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_BOOTCRC; + break; + default: + CRCCommand = XMEGA_NVM_CMD_FLASHCRC; + break; + } + + /* Perform and retrieve the memory CRC, indicate timeout if occurred */ + if (!(XMEGANVM_GetMemoryCRC(CRCCommand, &MemoryCRC))) + ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_TIMEOUT; + } + else + { + /* TPI does not support memory CRC */ + ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_FAILED; + } + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_XPROG); + Endpoint_Write_8(XPROG_CMD_CRC); + Endpoint_Write_8(ReturnStatus); + + if (ReturnStatus == XPROG_ERR_OK) + { + Endpoint_Write_8(MemoryCRC >> 16); + Endpoint_Write_16_LE(MemoryCRC & 0xFFFF); + } + + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +/** Handler for the XPROG SET_PARAM command to set a XPROG parameter for use when communicating with the + * attached device. + */ +static void XPROGProtocol_SetParam(void) +{ + uint8_t ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_OK; + + uint8_t XPROGParam = Endpoint_Read_8(); + + /* Determine which parameter is being set, store the new parameter value */ + switch (XPROGParam) + { + case XPROG_PARAM_NVMBASE: + XPROG_Param_NVMBase = Endpoint_Read_32_BE(); + break; + case XPROG_PARAM_EEPPAGESIZE: + XPROG_Param_EEPageSize = Endpoint_Read_16_BE(); + break; + case XPROG_PARAM_NVMCMD_REG: + XPROG_Param_NVMCMDRegAddr = Endpoint_Read_8(); + break; + case XPROG_PARAM_NVMCSR_REG: + XPROG_Param_NVMCSRRegAddr = Endpoint_Read_8(); + break; + case XPROG_PARAM_UNKNOWN_1: + /* TODO: Undocumented parameter added in AVRStudio 5.1, purpose unknown. Must ACK and discard or + the communication with AVRStudio 5.1 will fail. + */ + Endpoint_Discard_16(); + break; + default: + ReturnStatus = XPROG_ERR_FAILED; + break; + } + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR); + Endpoint_SetEndpointDirection(ENDPOINT_DIR_IN); + + Endpoint_Write_8(CMD_XPROG); + Endpoint_Write_8(XPROG_CMD_SET_PARAM); + Endpoint_Write_8(ReturnStatus); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGProtocol.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGProtocol.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e35a1e4a19 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGProtocol.h @@ -0,0 +1,136 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for XPROGProtocol.c. + */ + +#ifndef _XPROG_PROTOCOL_ +#define _XPROG_PROTOCOL_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <util/delay.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "../V2Protocol.h" + #include "XMEGANVM.h" + #include "TINYNVM.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + /* On the XPLAIN board, we only need PDI programming + for the ATXMEGA128A1 - disable ISP to prevent hardware + damage and force-enable XPROG. + */ + #undef ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL + + #if !defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) + #define ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL + #endif + #endif + + /* Macros: */ + #define XPROG_CMD_ENTER_PROGMODE 0x01 + #define XPROG_CMD_LEAVE_PROGMODE 0x02 + #define XPROG_CMD_ERASE 0x03 + #define XPROG_CMD_WRITE_MEM 0x04 + #define XPROG_CMD_READ_MEM 0x05 + #define XPROG_CMD_CRC 0x06 + #define XPROG_CMD_SET_PARAM 0x07 + + #define XPROG_MEM_TYPE_APPL 1 + #define XPROG_MEM_TYPE_BOOT 2 + #define XPROG_MEM_TYPE_EEPROM 3 + #define XPROG_MEM_TYPE_FUSE 4 + #define XPROG_MEM_TYPE_LOCKBITS 5 + #define XPROG_MEM_TYPE_USERSIG 6 + #define XPROG_MEM_TYPE_FACTORY_CALIBRATION 7 + + #define XPROG_ERASE_CHIP 1 + #define XPROG_ERASE_APP 2 + #define XPROG_ERASE_BOOT 3 + #define XPROG_ERASE_EEPROM 4 + #define XPROG_ERASE_APP_PAGE 5 + #define XPROG_ERASE_BOOT_PAGE 6 + #define XPROG_ERASE_EEPROM_PAGE 7 + #define XPROG_ERASE_USERSIG 8 + + #define XPROG_MEM_WRITE_ERASE 0 + #define XPROG_MEM_WRITE_WRITE 1 + + #define XPROG_CRC_APP 1 + #define XPROG_CRC_BOOT 2 + #define XPROG_CRC_FLASH 3 + + #define XPROG_ERR_OK 0 + #define XPROG_ERR_FAILED 1 + #define XPROG_ERR_COLLISION 2 + #define XPROG_ERR_TIMEOUT 3 + + #define XPROG_PARAM_NVMBASE 0x01 + #define XPROG_PARAM_EEPPAGESIZE 0x02 + #define XPROG_PARAM_NVMCMD_REG 0x03 + #define XPROG_PARAM_NVMCSR_REG 0x04 + #define XPROG_PARAM_UNKNOWN_1 0x05 + + #define XPROG_PROTOCOL_PDI 0x00 + #define XPROG_PROTOCOL_JTAG 0x01 + #define XPROG_PROTOCOL_TPI 0x02 + + #define XPROG_PAGEMODE_WRITE (1 << 1) + #define XPROG_PAGEMODE_ERASE (1 << 0) + + /* External Variables: */ + extern uint32_t XPROG_Param_NVMBase; + extern uint16_t XPROG_Param_EEPageSize; + extern uint8_t XPROG_Param_NVMCSRRegAddr; + extern uint8_t XPROG_Param_NVMCMDRegAddr; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void XPROGProtocol_SetMode(void); + void XPROGProtocol_Command(void); + + #if (defined(INCLUDE_FROM_XPROGPROTOCOL_C) && defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL)) + static void XPROGProtocol_EnterXPROGMode(void); + static void XPROGProtocol_LeaveXPROGMode(void); + static void XPROGProtocol_SetParam(void); + static void XPROGProtocol_Erase(void); + static void XPROGProtocol_WriteMemory(void); + static void XPROGProtocol_ReadMemory(void); + static void XPROGProtocol_ReadCRC(void); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGTarget.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGTarget.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0455329c3d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGTarget.c @@ -0,0 +1,209 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Target-related functions for the PDI Protocol decoder. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_XPROGTARGET_C +#include "XPROGTarget.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + +/** Flag to indicate if the USART is currently in Tx or Rx mode. */ +bool IsSending; + +/** Enables the target's PDI interface, holding the target in reset until PDI mode is exited. */ +void XPROGTarget_EnableTargetPDI(void) +{ + IsSending = false; + + /* Set Tx and XCK as outputs, Rx as input */ + DDRD |= (1 << 5) | (1 << 3); + DDRD &= ~(1 << 2); + + /* Set DATA line high for at least 90ns to disable /RESET functionality */ + PORTD |= (1 << 3); + _delay_us(100); + + /* Set up the synchronous USART for XMEGA communications - 8 data bits, even parity, 2 stop bits */ + UBRR1 = ((F_CPU / 2 / XPROG_HARDWARE_SPEED) - 1); + UCSR1B = (1 << TXEN1); + UCSR1C = (1 << UMSEL10) | (1 << UPM11) | (1 << USBS1) | (1 << UCSZ11) | (1 << UCSZ10) | (1 << UCPOL1); + + /* Send two IDLEs of 12 bits each to enable PDI interface (need at least 16 idle bits) */ + XPROGTarget_SendIdle(); + XPROGTarget_SendIdle(); +} + +/** Enables the target's TPI interface, holding the target in reset until TPI mode is exited. */ +void XPROGTarget_EnableTargetTPI(void) +{ + IsSending = false; + + /* Set /RESET line low for at least 400ns to enable TPI functionality */ + AUX_LINE_DDR |= AUX_LINE_MASK; + AUX_LINE_PORT &= ~AUX_LINE_MASK; + _delay_us(100); + + /* Set Tx and XCK as outputs, Rx as input */ + DDRD |= (1 << 5) | (1 << 3); + DDRD &= ~(1 << 2); + + /* Set up the synchronous USART for TPI communications - 8 data bits, even parity, 2 stop bits */ + UBRR1 = ((F_CPU / 2 / XPROG_HARDWARE_SPEED) - 1); + UCSR1B = (1 << TXEN1); + UCSR1C = (1 << UMSEL10) | (1 << UPM11) | (1 << USBS1) | (1 << UCSZ11) | (1 << UCSZ10) | (1 << UCPOL1); + + /* Send two IDLEs of 12 bits each to enable TPI interface (need at least 16 idle bits) */ + XPROGTarget_SendIdle(); + XPROGTarget_SendIdle(); +} + +/** Disables the target's PDI interface, exits programming mode and starts the target's application. */ +void XPROGTarget_DisableTargetPDI(void) +{ + /* Switch to Rx mode to ensure that all pending transmissions are complete */ + if (IsSending) + XPROGTarget_SetRxMode(); + + /* Turn off receiver and transmitter of the USART, clear settings */ + UCSR1A = ((1 << TXC1) | (1 << RXC1)); + UCSR1B = 0; + UCSR1C = 0; + + /* Tristate all pins */ + DDRD &= ~((1 << 5) | (1 << 3)); + PORTD &= ~((1 << 5) | (1 << 3) | (1 << 2)); +} + +/** Disables the target's TPI interface, exits programming mode and starts the target's application. */ +void XPROGTarget_DisableTargetTPI(void) +{ + /* Switch to Rx mode to ensure that all pending transmissions are complete */ + if (IsSending) + XPROGTarget_SetRxMode(); + + /* Turn off receiver and transmitter of the USART, clear settings */ + UCSR1A |= (1 << TXC1) | (1 << RXC1); + UCSR1B = 0; + UCSR1C = 0; + + /* Set all USART lines as inputs, tristate */ + DDRD &= ~((1 << 5) | (1 << 3)); + PORTD &= ~((1 << 5) | (1 << 3) | (1 << 2)); + + /* Tristate target /RESET line */ + AUX_LINE_DDR &= ~AUX_LINE_MASK; + AUX_LINE_PORT &= ~AUX_LINE_MASK; +} + +/** Sends a byte via the USART. + * + * \param[in] Byte Byte to send through the USART + */ +void XPROGTarget_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte) +{ + /* Switch to Tx mode if currently in Rx mode */ + if (!(IsSending)) + XPROGTarget_SetTxMode(); + + /* Wait until there is space in the hardware Tx buffer before writing */ + while (!(UCSR1A & (1 << UDRE1))); + UCSR1A |= (1 << TXC1); + UDR1 = Byte; +} + +/** Receives a byte via the hardware USART, blocking until data is received or timeout expired. + * + * \return Received byte from the USART + */ +uint8_t XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(void) +{ + /* Switch to Rx mode if currently in Tx mode */ + if (IsSending) + XPROGTarget_SetRxMode(); + + /* Wait until a byte has been received before reading */ + while (!(UCSR1A & (1 << RXC1)) && TimeoutTicksRemaining); + + return UDR1; +} + +/** Sends an IDLE via the USART to the attached target, consisting of a full frame of idle bits. */ +void XPROGTarget_SendIdle(void) +{ + /* Switch to Tx mode if currently in Rx mode */ + if (!(IsSending)) + XPROGTarget_SetTxMode(); + + /* Need to do nothing for a full frame to send an IDLE */ + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < BITS_IN_USART_FRAME; i++) + { + /* Wait for a full cycle of the clock */ + while (PIND & (1 << 5)); + while (!(PIND & (1 << 5))); + while (PIND & (1 << 5)); + } +} + +static void XPROGTarget_SetTxMode(void) +{ + /* Wait for a full cycle of the clock */ + while (PIND & (1 << 5)); + while (!(PIND & (1 << 5))); + while (PIND & (1 << 5)); + + PORTD |= (1 << 3); + DDRD |= (1 << 3); + + UCSR1B &= ~(1 << RXEN1); + UCSR1B |= (1 << TXEN1); + + IsSending = true; +} + +static void XPROGTarget_SetRxMode(void) +{ + while (!(UCSR1A & (1 << TXC1))); + UCSR1A |= (1 << TXC1); + + UCSR1B &= ~(1 << TXEN1); + UCSR1B |= (1 << RXEN1); + + DDRD &= ~(1 << 3); + PORTD &= ~(1 << 3); + + IsSending = false; +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGTarget.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGTarget.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1341384f2f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/Lib/XPROG/XPROGTarget.h @@ -0,0 +1,136 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for XPROGTarget.c. + */ + +#ifndef _XPROG_TARGET_ +#define _XPROG_TARGET_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + + #include "../V2Protocol.h" + #include "XPROGProtocol.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if ((BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN) || (BOARD == BOARD_XPLAIN_REV1)) + #undef ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL + + #if !defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL) + #define ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL + #endif + #endif + + /** Serial carrier TPI/PDI speed in Hz, when hardware TPI/PDI mode is used. */ + #define XPROG_HARDWARE_SPEED 2000000 + + /** Total number of bits in a single USART frame. */ + #define BITS_IN_USART_FRAME 12 + + /** \name PDI Related Constants + * @{ + */ + #define PDI_CMD_LDS(AddressSize, DataSize) (0x00 | ( AddressSize << 2) | DataSize) + #define PDI_CMD_LD(PointerAccess, DataSize) (0x20 | (PointerAccess << 2) | DataSize) + #define PDI_CMD_STS(AddressSize, DataSize) (0x40 | ( AddressSize << 2) | DataSize) + #define PDI_CMD_ST(PointerAccess, DataSize) (0x60 | (PointerAccess << 2) | DataSize) + #define PDI_CMD_LDCS(PDIReg) (0x80 | PDIReg) + #define PDI_CMD_REPEAT(DataSize) (0xA0 | DataSize) + #define PDI_CMD_STCS(PDIReg) (0xC0 | PDIReg) + #define PDI_CMD_KEY 0xE0 + + #define PDI_REG_STATUS 0 + #define PDI_REG_RESET 1 + #define PDI_REG_CTRL 2 + + #define PDI_STATUS_NVM (1 << 1) + + #define PDI_RESET_KEY 0x59 + #define PDI_NVMENABLE_KEY (uint8_t[]){0x12, 0x89, 0xAB, 0x45, 0xCD, 0xD8, 0x88, 0xFF} + + #define PDI_DATASIZE_1BYTE 0 + #define PDI_DATASIZE_2BYTES 1 + #define PDI_DATASIZE_3BYTES 2 + #define PDI_DATASIZE_4BYTES 3 + + #define PDI_POINTER_INDIRECT 0 + #define PDI_POINTER_INDIRECT_PI 1 + #define PDI_POINTER_DIRECT 2 + /** @} */ + + /** \name TPI Related Constants + * @{ + */ + #define TPI_CMD_SLD(PointerAccess) (0x20 | PointerAccess) + #define TPI_CMD_SST(PointerAccess) (0x60 | PointerAccess) + #define TPI_CMD_SSTPR 0x68 + #define TPI_CMD_SIN(Address) (0x10 | ((Address & 0x30) << 1) | (Address & 0x0F)) + #define TPI_CMD_SOUT(Address) (0x90 | ((Address & 0x30) << 1) | (Address & 0x0F)) + #define TPI_CMD_SLDCS(TPIReg) (0x80 | TPIReg) + #define TPI_CMD_SSTCS(TPIReg) (0xC0 | TPIReg) + #define TPI_CMD_SKEY 0xE0 + + #define TPI_REG_STATUS 0x00 + #define TPI_REG_CTRL 0x02 + #define TPI_REG_ID 0x0F + + #define TPI_STATUS_NVM (1 << 1) + + #define TPI_NVMENABLE_KEY (uint8_t[]){0x12, 0x89, 0xAB, 0x45, 0xCD, 0xD8, 0x88, 0xFF} + + #define TPI_POINTER_INDIRECT 0 + #define TPI_POINTER_INDIRECT_PI 4 + /** @} */ + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void XPROGTarget_EnableTargetPDI(void); + void XPROGTarget_EnableTargetTPI(void); + void XPROGTarget_DisableTargetPDI(void); + void XPROGTarget_DisableTargetTPI(void); + void XPROGTarget_SendByte(const uint8_t Byte); + uint8_t XPROGTarget_ReceiveByte(void); + void XPROGTarget_SendIdle(void); + bool XPROGTarget_WaitWhileNVMBusBusy(void); + + #if (defined(INCLUDE_FROM_XPROGTARGET_C) && defined(ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL)) + static void XPROGTarget_SetTxMode(void); + static void XPROGTarget_SetRxMode(void); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/AVRISP_mkII.inf b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/AVRISP_mkII.inf Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..81ea412280 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/AVRISP_mkII.inf diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/amd64/libusb0.dll b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/amd64/libusb0.dll Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f916b08986 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/amd64/libusb0.dll diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/amd64/libusb0.sys b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/amd64/libusb0.sys Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0718dfb7c0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/amd64/libusb0.sys diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/avrisp_mkii.cat b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/avrisp_mkii.cat Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9f004a584c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/avrisp_mkii.cat diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/ia64/libusb0.dll b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/ia64/libusb0.dll Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..292df27857 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/ia64/libusb0.dll diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/ia64/libusb0.sys b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/ia64/libusb0.sys Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f17914b8c4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/ia64/libusb0.sys diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/installer_x64.exe b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/installer_x64.exe Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c38919ee50 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/installer_x64.exe diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/installer_x86.exe b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/installer_x86.exe Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..030ec300c2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/installer_x86.exe diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/license/libusb0/installer_license.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/license/libusb0/installer_license.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..56bb2cda25 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/license/libusb0/installer_license.txt @@ -0,0 +1,851 @@ +Copyright (c) 2002-2004 Stephan Meyer, <ste_meyer@web.de> +Copyright (c) 2000-2004 Johannes Erdfelt, <johannes@erdfelt.com> +Copyright (c) 2000-2004 Thomas Sailer, <sailer@ife.ee.ethz.ch> +Copyright (c) 2010 Travis Robinson, <libusbdotnet@gmail.com> + +This software is distributed under the following licenses: +Driver: GNU General Public License (GPL) +Library, Test Files, Installer: GNU Lesser General Public License (LGPL) + +*********************************************************************** + GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE + Version 3, 29 June 2007 + + Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/> + Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies + of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. + + Preamble + + The GNU General Public License is a free, copyleft license for +software and other kinds of works. + + The licenses for most software and other practical works are designed +to take away your freedom to share and change the works. By contrast, +the GNU General Public License is intended to guarantee your freedom to +share and change all versions of a program--to make sure it remains free +software for all its users. We, the Free Software Foundation, use the +GNU General Public License for most of our software; it applies also to +any other work released this way by its authors. You can apply it to +your programs, too. + + When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not +price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you +have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for +them if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you +want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new +free programs, and that you know you can do these things. + + To protect your rights, we need to prevent others from denying you +these rights or asking you to surrender the rights. Therefore, you have +certain responsibilities if you distribute copies of the software, or if +you modify it: responsibilities to respect the freedom of others. + + For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether +gratis or for a fee, you must pass on to the recipients the same +freedoms that you received. You must make sure that they, too, receive +or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so they +know their rights. + + Developers that use the GNU GPL protect your rights with two steps: +(1) assert copyright on the software, and (2) offer you this License +giving you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify it. + + For the developers' and authors' protection, the GPL clearly explains +that there is no warranty for this free software. For both users' and +authors' sake, the GPL requires that modified versions be marked as +changed, so that their problems will not be attributed erroneously to +authors of previous versions. + + Some devices are designed to deny users access to install or run +modified versions of the software inside them, although the manufacturer +can do so. This is fundamentally incompatible with the aim of +protecting users' freedom to change the software. The systematic +pattern of such abuse occurs in the area of products for individuals to +use, which is precisely where it is most unacceptable. Therefore, we +have designed this version of the GPL to prohibit the practice for those +products. If such problems arise substantially in other domains, we +stand ready to extend this provision to those domains in future versions +of the GPL, as needed to protect the freedom of users. + + Finally, every program is threatened constantly by software patents. +States should not allow patents to restrict development and use of +software on general-purpose computers, but in those that do, we wish to +avoid the special danger that patents applied to a free program could +make it effectively proprietary. To prevent this, the GPL assures that +patents cannot be used to render the program non-free. + + The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and +modification follow. + + TERMS AND CONDITIONS + + 0. Definitions. + + "This License" refers to version 3 of the GNU General Public License. + + "Copyright" also means copyright-like laws that apply to other kinds of +works, such as semiconductor masks. + + "The Program" refers to any copyrightable work licensed under this +License. Each licensee is addressed as "you". "Licensees" and +"recipients" may be individuals or organizations. + + To "modify" a work means to copy from or adapt all or part of the work +in a fashion requiring copyright permission, other than the making of an +exact copy. The resulting work is called a "modified version" of the +earlier work or a work "based on" the earlier work. + + A "covered work" means either the unmodified Program or a work based +on the Program. + + To "propagate" a work means to do anything with it that, without +permission, would make you directly or secondarily liable for +infringement under applicable copyright law, except executing it on a +computer or modifying a private copy. Propagation includes copying, +distribution (with or without modification), making available to the +public, and in some countries other activities as well. + + To "convey" a work means any kind of propagation that enables other +parties to make or receive copies. Mere interaction with a user through +a computer network, with no transfer of a copy, is not conveying. + + An interactive user interface displays "Appropriate Legal Notices" +to the extent that it includes a convenient and prominently visible +feature that (1) displays an appropriate copyright notice, and (2) +tells the user that there is no warranty for the work (except to the +extent that warranties are provided), that licensees may convey the +work under this License, and how to view a copy of this License. If +the interface presents a list of user commands or options, such as a +menu, a prominent item in the list meets this criterion. + + 1. Source Code. + + The "source code" for a work means the preferred form of the work +for making modifications to it. "Object code" means any non-source +form of a work. + + A "Standard Interface" means an interface that either is an official +standard defined by a recognized standards body, or, in the case of +interfaces specified for a particular programming language, one that +is widely used among developers working in that language. + + The "System Libraries" of an executable work include anything, other +than the work as a whole, that (a) is included in the normal form of +packaging a Major Component, but which is not part of that Major +Component, and (b) serves only to enable use of the work with that +Major Component, or to implement a Standard Interface for which an +implementation is available to the public in source code form. A +"Major Component", in this context, means a major essential component +(kernel, window system, and so on) of the specific operating system +(if any) on which the executable work runs, or a compiler used to +produce the work, or an object code interpreter used to run it. + + The "Corresponding Source" for a work in object code form means all +the source code needed to generate, install, and (for an executable +work) run the object code and to modify the work, including scripts to +control those activities. However, it does not include the work's +System Libraries, or general-purpose tools or generally available free +programs which are used unmodified in performing those activities but +which are not part of the work. For example, Corresponding Source +includes interface definition files associated with source files for +the work, and the source code for shared libraries and dynamically +linked subprograms that the work is specifically designed to require, +such as by intimate data communication or control flow between those +subprograms and other parts of the work. + + The Corresponding Source need not include anything that users +can regenerate automatically from other parts of the Corresponding +Source. + + The Corresponding Source for a work in source code form is that +same work. + + 2. Basic Permissions. + + All rights granted under this License are granted for the term of +copyright on the Program, and are irrevocable provided the stated +conditions are met. This License explicitly affirms your unlimited +permission to run the unmodified Program. The output from running a +covered work is covered by this License only if the output, given its +content, constitutes a covered work. This License acknowledges your +rights of fair use or other equivalent, as provided by copyright law. + + You may make, run and propagate covered works that you do not +convey, without conditions so long as your license otherwise remains +in force. You may convey covered works to others for the sole purpose +of having them make modifications exclusively for you, or provide you +with facilities for running those works, provided that you comply with +the terms of this License in conveying all material for which you do +not control copyright. Those thus making or running the covered works +for you must do so exclusively on your behalf, under your direction +and control, on terms that prohibit them from making any copies of +your copyrighted material outside their relationship with you. + + Conveying under any other circumstances is permitted solely under +the conditions stated below. Sublicensing is not allowed; section 10 +makes it unnecessary. + + 3. Protecting Users' Legal Rights From Anti-Circumvention Law. + + No covered work shall be deemed part of an effective technological +measure under any applicable law fulfilling obligations under article +11 of the WIPO copyright treaty adopted on 20 December 1996, or +similar laws prohibiting or restricting circumvention of such +measures. + + When you convey a covered work, you waive any legal power to forbid +circumvention of technological measures to the extent such circumvention +is effected by exercising rights under this License with respect to +the covered work, and you disclaim any intention to limit operation or +modification of the work as a means of enforcing, against the work's +users, your or third parties' legal rights to forbid circumvention of +technological measures. + + 4. Conveying Verbatim Copies. + + You may convey verbatim copies of the Program's source code as you +receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and +appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice; +keep intact all notices stating that this License and any +non-permissive terms added in accord with section 7 apply to the code; +keep intact all notices of the absence of any warranty; and give all +recipients a copy of this License along with the Program. + + You may charge any price or no price for each copy that you convey, +and you may offer support or warranty protection for a fee. + + 5. Conveying Modified Source Versions. + + You may convey a work based on the Program, or the modifications to +produce it from the Program, in the form of source code under the +terms of section 4, provided that you also meet all of these conditions: + + a) The work must carry prominent notices stating that you modified + it, and giving a relevant date. + + b) The work must carry prominent notices stating that it is + released under this License and any conditions added under section + 7. This requirement modifies the requirement in section 4 to + "keep intact all notices". + + c) You must license the entire work, as a whole, under this + License to anyone who comes into possession of a copy. This + License will therefore apply, along with any applicable section 7 + additional terms, to the whole of the work, and all its parts, + regardless of how they are packaged. This License gives no + permission to license the work in any other way, but it does not + invalidate such permission if you have separately received it. + + d) If the work has interactive user interfaces, each must display + Appropriate Legal Notices; however, if the Program has interactive + interfaces that do not display Appropriate Legal Notices, your + work need not make them do so. + + A compilation of a covered work with other separate and independent +works, which are not by their nature extensions of the covered work, +and which are not combined with it such as to form a larger program, +in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an +"aggregate" if the compilation and its resulting copyright are not +used to limit the access or legal rights of the compilation's users +beyond what the individual works permit. Inclusion of a covered work +in an aggregate does not cause this License to apply to the other +parts of the aggregate. + + 6. Conveying Non-Source Forms. + + You may convey a covered work in object code form under the terms +of sections 4 and 5, provided that you also convey the +machine-readable Corresponding Source under the terms of this License, +in one of these ways: + + a) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product + (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by the + Corresponding Source fixed on a durable physical medium + customarily used for software interchange. + + b) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product + (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by a + written offer, valid for at least three years and valid for as + long as you offer spare parts or customer support for that product + model, to give anyone who possesses the object code either (1) a + copy of the Corresponding Source for all the software in the + product that is covered by this License, on a durable physical + medium customarily used for software interchange, for a price no + more than your reasonable cost of physically performing this + conveying of source, or (2) access to copy the + Corresponding Source from a network server at no charge. + + c) Convey individual copies of the object code with a copy of the + written offer to provide the Corresponding Source. This + alternative is allowed only occasionally and noncommercially, and + only if you received the object code with such an offer, in accord + with subsection 6b. + + d) Convey the object code by offering access from a designated + place (gratis or for a charge), and offer equivalent access to the + Corresponding Source in the same way through the same place at no + further charge. You need not require recipients to copy the + Corresponding Source along with the object code. If the place to + copy the object code is a network server, the Corresponding Source + may be on a different server (operated by you or a third party) + that supports equivalent copying facilities, provided you maintain + clear directions next to the object code saying where to find the + Corresponding Source. Regardless of what server hosts the + Corresponding Source, you remain obligated to ensure that it is + available for as long as needed to satisfy these requirements. + + e) Convey the object code using peer-to-peer transmission, provided + you inform other peers where the object code and Corresponding + Source of the work are being offered to the general public at no + charge under subsection 6d. + + A separable portion of the object code, whose source code is excluded +from the Corresponding Source as a System Library, need not be +included in conveying the object code work. + + A "User Product" is either (1) a "consumer product", which means any +tangible personal property which is normally used for personal, family, +or household purposes, or (2) anything designed or sold for incorporation +into a dwelling. In determining whether a product is a consumer product, +doubtful cases shall be resolved in favor of coverage. For a particular +product received by a particular user, "normally used" refers to a +typical or common use of that class of product, regardless of the status +of the particular user or of the way in which the particular user +actually uses, or expects or is expected to use, the product. A product +is a consumer product regardless of whether the product has substantial +commercial, industrial or non-consumer uses, unless such uses represent +the only significant mode of use of the product. + + "Installation Information" for a User Product means any methods, +procedures, authorization keys, or other information required to install +and execute modified versions of a covered work in that User Product from +a modified version of its Corresponding Source. The information must +suffice to ensure that the continued functioning of the modified object +code is in no case prevented or interfered with solely because +modification has been made. + + If you convey an object code work under this section in, or with, or +specifically for use in, a User Product, and the conveying occurs as +part of a transaction in which the right of possession and use of the +User Product is transferred to the recipient in perpetuity or for a +fixed term (regardless of how the transaction is characterized), the +Corresponding Source conveyed under this section must be accompanied +by the Installation Information. But this requirement does not apply +if neither you nor any third party retains the ability to install +modified object code on the User Product (for example, the work has +been installed in ROM). + + The requirement to provide Installation Information does not include a +requirement to continue to provide support service, warranty, or updates +for a work that has been modified or installed by the recipient, or for +the User Product in which it has been modified or installed. Access to a +network may be denied when the modification itself materially and +adversely affects the operation of the network or violates the rules and +protocols for communication across the network. + + Corresponding Source conveyed, and Installation Information provided, +in accord with this section must be in a format that is publicly +documented (and with an implementation available to the public in +source code form), and must require no special password or key for +unpacking, reading or copying. + + 7. Additional Terms. + + "Additional permissions" are terms that supplement the terms of this +License by making exceptions from one or more of its conditions. +Additional permissions that are applicable to the entire Program shall +be treated as though they were included in this License, to the extent +that they are valid under applicable law. If additional permissions +apply only to part of the Program, that part may be used separately +under those permissions, but the entire Program remains governed by +this License without regard to the additional permissions. + + When you convey a copy of a covered work, you may at your option +remove any additional permissions from that copy, or from any part of +it. (Additional permissions may be written to require their own +removal in certain cases when you modify the work.) You may place +additional permissions on material, added by you to a covered work, +for which you have or can give appropriate copyright permission. + + Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, for material you +add to a covered work, you may (if authorized by the copyright holders of +that material) supplement the terms of this License with terms: + + a) Disclaiming warranty or limiting liability differently from the + terms of sections 15 and 16 of this License; or + + b) Requiring preservation of specified reasonable legal notices or + author attributions in that material or in the Appropriate Legal + Notices displayed by works containing it; or + + c) Prohibiting misrepresentation of the origin of that material, or + requiring that modified versions of such material be marked in + reasonable ways as different from the original version; or + + d) Limiting the use for publicity purposes of names of licensors or + authors of the material; or + + e) Declining to grant rights under trademark law for use of some + trade names, trademarks, or service marks; or + + f) Requiring indemnification of licensors and authors of that + material by anyone who conveys the material (or modified versions of + it) with contractual assumptions of liability to the recipient, for + any liability that these contractual assumptions directly impose on + those licensors and authors. + + All other non-permissive additional terms are considered "further +restrictions" within the meaning of section 10. If the Program as you +received it, or any part of it, contains a notice stating that it is +governed by this License along with a term that is a further +restriction, you may remove that term. If a license document contains +a further restriction but permits relicensing or conveying under this +License, you may add to a covered work material governed by the terms +of that license document, provided that the further restriction does +not survive such relicensing or conveying. + + If you add terms to a covered work in accord with this section, you +must place, in the relevant source files, a statement of the +additional terms that apply to those files, or a notice indicating +where to find the applicable terms. + + Additional terms, permissive or non-permissive, may be stated in the +form of a separately written license, or stated as exceptions; +the above requirements apply either way. + + 8. Termination. + + You may not propagate or modify a covered work except as expressly +provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to propagate or +modify it is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under +this License (including any patent licenses granted under the third +paragraph of section 11). + + However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your +license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a) +provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and +finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright +holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means +prior to 60 days after the cessation. + + Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is +reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the +violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have +received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that +copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after +your receipt of the notice. + + Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the +licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under +this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently +reinstated, you do not qualify to receive new licenses for the same +material under section 10. + + 9. Acceptance Not Required for Having Copies. + + You are not required to accept this License in order to receive or +run a copy of the Program. Ancillary propagation of a covered work +occurring solely as a consequence of using peer-to-peer transmission +to receive a copy likewise does not require acceptance. However, +nothing other than this License grants you permission to propagate or +modify any covered work. These actions infringe copyright if you do +not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or propagating a +covered work, you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so. + + 10. Automatic Licensing of Downstream Recipients. + + Each time you convey a covered work, the recipient automatically +receives a license from the original licensors, to run, modify and +propagate that work, subject to this License. You are not responsible +for enforcing compliance by third parties with this License. + + An "entity transaction" is a transaction transferring control of an +organization, or substantially all assets of one, or subdividing an +organization, or merging organizations. If propagation of a covered +work results from an entity transaction, each party to that +transaction who receives a copy of the work also receives whatever +licenses to the work the party's predecessor in interest had or could +give under the previous paragraph, plus a right to possession of the +Corresponding Source of the work from the predecessor in interest, if +the predecessor has it or can get it with reasonable efforts. + + You may not impose any further restrictions on the exercise of the +rights granted or affirmed under this License. For example, you may +not impose a license fee, royalty, or other charge for exercise of +rights granted under this License, and you may not initiate litigation +(including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that +any patent claim is infringed by making, using, selling, offering for +sale, or importing the Program or any portion of it. + + 11. Patents. + + A "contributor" is a copyright holder who authorizes use under this +License of the Program or a work on which the Program is based. The +work thus licensed is called the contributor's "contributor version". + + A contributor's "essential patent claims" are all patent claims +owned or controlled by the contributor, whether already acquired or +hereafter acquired, that would be infringed by some manner, permitted +by this License, of making, using, or selling its contributor version, +but do not include claims that would be infringed only as a +consequence of further modification of the contributor version. For +purposes of this definition, "control" includes the right to grant +patent sublicenses in a manner consistent with the requirements of +this License. + + Each contributor grants you a non-exclusive, worldwide, royalty-free +patent license under the contributor's essential patent claims, to +make, use, sell, offer for sale, import and otherwise run, modify and +propagate the contents of its contributor version. + + In the following three paragraphs, a "patent license" is any express +agreement or commitment, however denominated, not to enforce a patent +(such as an express permission to practice a patent or covenant not to +sue for patent infringement). To "grant" such a patent license to a +party means to make such an agreement or commitment not to enforce a +patent against the party. + + If you convey a covered work, knowingly relying on a patent license, +and the Corresponding Source of the work is not available for anyone +to copy, free of charge and under the terms of this License, through a +publicly available network server or other readily accessible means, +then you must either (1) cause the Corresponding Source to be so +available, or (2) arrange to deprive yourself of the benefit of the +patent license for this particular work, or (3) arrange, in a manner +consistent with the requirements of this License, to extend the patent +license to downstream recipients. "Knowingly relying" means you have +actual knowledge that, but for the patent license, your conveying the +covered work in a country, or your recipient's use of the covered work +in a country, would infringe one or more identifiable patents in that +country that you have reason to believe are valid. + + If, pursuant to or in connection with a single transaction or +arrangement, you convey, or propagate by procuring conveyance of, a +covered work, and grant a patent license to some of the parties +receiving the covered work authorizing them to use, propagate, modify +or convey a specific copy of the covered work, then the patent license +you grant is automatically extended to all recipients of the covered +work and works based on it. + + A patent license is "discriminatory" if it does not include within +the scope of its coverage, prohibits the exercise of, or is +conditioned on the non-exercise of one or more of the rights that are +specifically granted under this License. You may not convey a covered +work if you are a party to an arrangement with a third party that is +in the business of distributing software, under which you make payment +to the third party based on the extent of your activity of conveying +the work, and under which the third party grants, to any of the +parties who would receive the covered work from you, a discriminatory +patent license (a) in connection with copies of the covered work +conveyed by you (or copies made from those copies), or (b) primarily +for and in connection with specific products or compilations that +contain the covered work, unless you entered into that arrangement, +or that patent license was granted, prior to 28 March 2007. + + Nothing in this License shall be construed as excluding or limiting +any implied license or other defenses to infringement that may +otherwise be available to you under applicable patent law. + + 12. No Surrender of Others' Freedom. + + If conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or +otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not +excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot convey a +covered work so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this +License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may +not convey it at all. For example, if you agree to terms that obligate you +to collect a royalty for further conveying from those to whom you convey +the Program, the only way you could satisfy both those terms and this +License would be to refrain entirely from conveying the Program. + + 13. Use with the GNU Affero General Public License. + + Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, you have +permission to link or combine any covered work with a work licensed +under version 3 of the GNU Affero General Public License into a single +combined work, and to convey the resulting work. The terms of this +License will continue to apply to the part which is the covered work, +but the special requirements of the GNU Affero General Public License, +section 13, concerning interaction through a network will apply to the +combination as such. + + 14. Revised Versions of this License. + + The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of +the GNU General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will +be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to +address new problems or concerns. + + Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the +Program specifies that a certain numbered version of the GNU General +Public License "or any later version" applies to it, you have the +option of following the terms and conditions either of that numbered +version or of any later version published by the Free Software +Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of the +GNU General Public License, you may choose any version ever published +by the Free Software Foundation. + + If the Program specifies that a proxy can decide which future +versions of the GNU General Public License can be used, that proxy's +public statement of acceptance of a version permanently authorizes you +to choose that version for the Program. + + Later license versions may give you additional or different +permissions. However, no additional obligations are imposed on any +author or copyright holder as a result of your choosing to follow a +later version. + + 15. Disclaimer of Warranty. + + THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY +APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT +HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY +OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, +THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR +PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM +IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF +ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION. + + 16. Limitation of Liability. + + IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING +WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MODIFIES AND/OR CONVEYS +THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY +GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE +USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF +DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD +PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), +EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF +SUCH DAMAGES. + + 17. Interpretation of Sections 15 and 16. + + If the disclaimer of warranty and limitation of liability provided +above cannot be given local legal effect according to their terms, +reviewing courts shall apply local law that most closely approximates +an absolute waiver of all civil liability in connection with the +Program, unless a warranty or assumption of liability accompanies a +copy of the Program in return for a fee. + + END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS + + How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs + + If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest +possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it +free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms. + + To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest +to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively +state the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least +the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found. + + <one line to give the program's name and a brief idea of what it does.> + Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> + + This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify + it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by + the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or + (at your option) any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the + GNU General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License + along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. + +Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail. + + If the program does terminal interaction, make it output a short +notice like this when it starts in an interactive mode: + + <program> Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> + This program comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show w'. + This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it + under certain conditions; type `show c' for details. + +The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should show the appropriate +parts of the General Public License. Of course, your program's commands +might be different; for a GUI interface, you would use an "about box". + + You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or school, +if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the program, if necessary. +For more information on this, and how to apply and follow the GNU GPL, see +<http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. + + The GNU General Public License does not permit incorporating your program +into proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you +may consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with +the library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General +Public License instead of this License. But first, please read +<http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/why-not-lgpl.html>. + + GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE + Version 3, 29 June 2007 + + Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/> + Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies + of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. + + + This version of the GNU Lesser General Public License incorporates +the terms and conditions of version 3 of the GNU General Public +License, supplemented by the additional permissions listed below. + + 0. Additional Definitions. + + As used herein, "this License" refers to version 3 of the GNU Lesser +General Public License, and the "GNU GPL" refers to version 3 of the GNU +General Public License. + + "The Library" refers to a covered work governed by this License, +other than an Application or a Combined Work as defined below. + + An "Application" is any work that makes use of an interface provided +by the Library, but which is not otherwise based on the Library. +Defining a subclass of a class defined by the Library is deemed a mode +of using an interface provided by the Library. + + A "Combined Work" is a work produced by combining or linking an +Application with the Library. The particular version of the Library +with which the Combined Work was made is also called the "Linked +Version". + + The "Minimal Corresponding Source" for a Combined Work means the +Corresponding Source for the Combined Work, excluding any source code +for portions of the Combined Work that, considered in isolation, are +based on the Application, and not on the Linked Version. + + The "Corresponding Application Code" for a Combined Work means the +object code and/or source code for the Application, including any data +and utility programs needed for reproducing the Combined Work from the +Application, but excluding the System Libraries of the Combined Work. + + 1. Exception to Section 3 of the GNU GPL. + + You may convey a covered work under sections 3 and 4 of this License +without being bound by section 3 of the GNU GPL. + + 2. Conveying Modified Versions. + + If you modify a copy of the Library, and, in your modifications, a +facility refers to a function or data to be supplied by an Application +that uses the facility (other than as an argument passed when the +facility is invoked), then you may convey a copy of the modified +version: + + a) under this License, provided that you make a good faith effort to + ensure that, in the event an Application does not supply the + function or data, the facility still operates, and performs + whatever part of its purpose remains meaningful, or + + b) under the GNU GPL, with none of the additional permissions of + this License applicable to that copy. + + 3. Object Code Incorporating Material from Library Header Files. + + The object code form of an Application may incorporate material from +a header file that is part of the Library. You may convey such object +code under terms of your choice, provided that, if the incorporated +material is not limited to numerical parameters, data structure +layouts and accessors, or small macros, inline functions and templates +(ten or fewer lines in length), you do both of the following: + + a) Give prominent notice with each copy of the object code that the + Library is used in it and that the Library and its use are + covered by this License. + + b) Accompany the object code with a copy of the GNU GPL and this license + document. + + 4. Combined Works. + + You may convey a Combined Work under terms of your choice that, +taken together, effectively do not restrict modification of the +portions of the Library contained in the Combined Work and reverse +engineering for debugging such modifications, if you also do each of +the following: + + a) Give prominent notice with each copy of the Combined Work that + the Library is used in it and that the Library and its use are + covered by this License. + + b) Accompany the Combined Work with a copy of the GNU GPL and this license + document. + + c) For a Combined Work that displays copyright notices during + execution, include the copyright notice for the Library among + these notices, as well as a reference directing the user to the + copies of the GNU GPL and this license document. + + d) Do one of the following: + + 0) Convey the Minimal Corresponding Source under the terms of this + License, and the Corresponding Application Code in a form + suitable for, and under terms that permit, the user to + recombine or relink the Application with a modified version of + the Linked Version to produce a modified Combined Work, in the + manner specified by section 6 of the GNU GPL for conveying + Corresponding Source. + + 1) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking with the + Library. A suitable mechanism is one that (a) uses at run time + a copy of the Library already present on the user's computer + system, and (b) will operate properly with a modified version + of the Library that is interface-compatible with the Linked + Version. + + e) Provide Installation Information, but only if you would otherwise + be required to provide such information under section 6 of the + GNU GPL, and only to the extent that such information is + necessary to install and execute a modified version of the + Combined Work produced by recombining or relinking the + Application with a modified version of the Linked Version. (If + you use option 4d0, the Installation Information must accompany + the Minimal Corresponding Source and Corresponding Application + Code. If you use option 4d1, you must provide the Installation + Information in the manner specified by section 6 of the GNU GPL + for conveying Corresponding Source.) + + 5. Combined Libraries. + + You may place library facilities that are a work based on the +Library side by side in a single library together with other library +facilities that are not Applications and are not covered by this +License, and convey such a combined library under terms of your +choice, if you do both of the following: + + a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of the same work based + on the Library, uncombined with any other library facilities, + conveyed under the terms of this License. + + b) Give prominent notice with the combined library that part of it + is a work based on the Library, and explaining where to find the + accompanying uncombined form of the same work. + + 6. Revised Versions of the GNU Lesser General Public License. + + The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions +of the GNU Lesser General Public License from time to time. Such new +versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may +differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. + + Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the +Library as you received it specifies that a certain numbered version +of the GNU Lesser General Public License "or any later version" +applies to it, you have the option of following the terms and +conditions either of that published version or of any later version +published by the Free Software Foundation. If the Library as you +received it does not specify a version number of the GNU Lesser +General Public License, you may choose any version of the GNU Lesser +General Public License ever published by the Free Software Foundation. + + If the Library as you received it specifies that a proxy can decide +whether future versions of the GNU Lesser General Public License shall +apply, that proxy's public statement of acceptance of any version is +permanent authorization for you to choose that version for the +Library. + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/x86/libusb0.sys b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/x86/libusb0.sys Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5322e5b978 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/x86/libusb0.sys diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/x86/libusb0_x86.dll b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/x86/libusb0_x86.dll Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6e475b90ac --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/WindowsDriver/x86/libusb0_x86.dll diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..11467236b8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,91 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="AVRISP-MKII Clone Programmer" id="lufa.projects.avrispmkii_clone.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.projects.avrispmkii_clone"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="usbkey"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="8000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="8000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <!-- Required by the XPLAIN Bridge project as well, so split into a meta module -->
+ <module type="meta" id="lufa.projects.avrispmkii_clone.src" caption="AVRISP-MKII Clone Programmer">
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="hidden"/>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value="."/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="AVRISPDescriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="AVRISPDescriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="include-path" value="Lib"/>
+
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/V2ProtocolConstants.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/V2Protocol.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/V2Protocol.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/V2ProtocolParams.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/V2ProtocolParams.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/ISP/ISPProtocol.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/ISP/ISPProtocol.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/ISP/ISPTarget.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/ISP/ISPTarget.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/XPROG/XPROGTarget.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/XPROG/XPROGTarget.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/XPROG/XPROGProtocol.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/XPROG/XPROGProtocol.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/XPROG/XMEGANVM.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/XPROG/XMEGANVM.h"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/XPROG/TINYNVM.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/XPROG/TINYNVM.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.adc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.spi"/>
+ </module>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.projects.avrispmkii_clone" caption="AVRISP-MKII Clone Programmer">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Clone firmware of the Atmel AVRISP-MKII programmer.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="AVRISP-MKII.txt"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="directory" value="WindowsDriver"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="AVRISP-MKII.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="AVRISP-MKII.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.projects.avrispmkii_clone.src"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.adc"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.spi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..faba2c70d2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2396 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "AVRISP-MKII Clone Programmer Project" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ \ + WindowsDriver/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/makefile b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6bc0e0f25a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/AVRISP-MKII/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,44 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = AVRISP-MKII +SRC = $(TARGET).c AVRISPDescriptors.c Lib/V2Protocol.c Lib/V2ProtocolParams.c Lib/ISP/ISPProtocol.c Lib/ISP/ISPTarget.c Lib/XPROG/XPROGProtocol.c \ + Lib/XPROG/XPROGTarget.c Lib/XPROG/XMEGANVM.c Lib/XPROG/TINYNVM.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Benito.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Benito.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..93a39cb7bc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Benito.c @@ -0,0 +1,311 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the Benito project. This file contains the main tasks of + * the project and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "Benito.h" + +/** Circular buffer to hold data from the serial port before it is sent to the host. */ +static RingBuffer_t USARTtoUSB_Buffer; + +/** Underlying data buffer for \ref USARTtoUSB_Buffer, where the stored bytes are located. */ +static uint8_t USARTtoUSB_Buffer_Data[128]; + +/** Pulse generation counters to keep track of the number of milliseconds remaining for each pulse type */ +volatile struct +{ + uint8_t ResetPulse; /**< Milliseconds remaining for target /RESET pulse */ + uint8_t TxLEDPulse; /**< Milliseconds remaining for data Tx LED pulse */ + uint8_t RxLEDPulse; /**< Milliseconds remaining for data Rx LED pulse */ + uint8_t PingPongLEDPulse; /**< Milliseconds remaining for enumeration Tx/Rx ping-pong LED pulse */ +} PulseMSRemaining; + +/** Milliseconds remaining until the receive buffer is flushed to the USB host */ +uint8_t FlushPeriodRemaining = RECEIVE_BUFFER_FLUSH_MS; + +/** LUFA CDC Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all CDC Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .ControlInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + }, + }; + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + RingBuffer_InitBuffer(&USARTtoUSB_Buffer, USARTtoUSB_Buffer_Data, sizeof(USARTtoUSB_Buffer_Data)); + + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + /* Echo bytes from the host to the target via the hardware USART */ + if ((UCSR1A & (1 << UDRE1)) && CDC_Device_BytesReceived(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface)) + { + UDR1 = CDC_Device_ReceiveByte(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + + LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(LEDMASK_TX); + PulseMSRemaining.TxLEDPulse = TX_RX_LED_PULSE_MS; + } + + /* Check if the millisecond timer has elapsed */ + if (TIFR0 & (1 << OCF0A)) + { + /* Clear flush timer expiry flag */ + TIFR0 |= (1 << TOV0); + + /* Check if the reset pulse period has elapsed, if so tristate the target reset line */ + if (PulseMSRemaining.ResetPulse && !(--PulseMSRemaining.ResetPulse)) + { + LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(LEDMASK_BUSY); + AVR_RESET_LINE_DDR &= ~AVR_RESET_LINE_MASK; + } + + /* Check if the LEDs should be ping-ponging (during enumeration) */ + if (PulseMSRemaining.PingPongLEDPulse && !(--PulseMSRemaining.PingPongLEDPulse)) + { + LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDMASK_TX | LEDMASK_RX); + PulseMSRemaining.PingPongLEDPulse = PING_PONG_LED_PULSE_MS; + } + + /* Turn off TX LED(s) once the TX pulse period has elapsed */ + if (PulseMSRemaining.TxLEDPulse && !(--PulseMSRemaining.TxLEDPulse)) + LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(LEDMASK_TX); + + /* Turn off RX LED(s) once the RX pulse period has elapsed */ + if (PulseMSRemaining.RxLEDPulse && !(--PulseMSRemaining.RxLEDPulse)) + LEDs_TurnOffLEDs(LEDMASK_RX); + + /* Check if the receive buffer flush period has expired */ + uint16_t BufferCount = RingBuffer_GetCount(&USARTtoUSB_Buffer); + if (!(--FlushPeriodRemaining) || (BufferCount > 200)) + { + FlushPeriodRemaining = RECEIVE_BUFFER_FLUSH_MS; + + /* Start RX LED indicator pulse */ + if (BufferCount) + { + LEDs_TurnOnLEDs(LEDMASK_RX); + PulseMSRemaining.RxLEDPulse = TX_RX_LED_PULSE_MS; + } + + /* Echo bytes from the target to the host via the virtual serial port */ + while (BufferCount--) + { + /* Try to send the next byte of data to the host, abort if there is an error without dequeuing */ + if (CDC_Device_SendByte(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface, + RingBuffer_Peek(&USARTtoUSB_Buffer)) != ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError) + { + break; + } + + /* Dequeue the already sent byte from the buffer now we have confirmed that no transmission error occurred */ + RingBuffer_Remove(&USARTtoUSB_Buffer); + } + } + } + + CDC_Device_USBTask(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Millisecond Timer Interrupt */ + OCR0A = (F_CPU / 64 / 1000); + TCCR0A = (1 << WGM01); + TCCR0B = ((1 << CS01) | (1 << CS00)); + + /* Tristate target /RESET Line */ + AVR_RESET_LINE_PORT &= ~AVR_RESET_LINE_MASK; + AVR_RESET_LINE_DDR &= ~AVR_RESET_LINE_MASK; +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + PulseMSRemaining.PingPongLEDPulse = PING_PONG_LED_PULSE_MS; + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_TX); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + PulseMSRemaining.PingPongLEDPulse = 0; + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDS_NO_LEDS); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= CDC_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + + PulseMSRemaining.PingPongLEDPulse = 0; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDS_NO_LEDS : LEDMASK_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_ControlRequest event. This is used to catch and process control requests sent to + * the device from the USB host before passing along unhandled control requests to the library for processing + * internally. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + CDC_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); +} + +/** Event handler for the CDC Class driver Line Encoding Changed event. + * + * \param[in] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to the CDC class interface configuration structure being referenced + */ +void EVENT_CDC_Device_LineEncodingChanged(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint8_t ConfigMask = 0; + + switch (CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.ParityType) + { + case CDC_PARITY_Odd: + ConfigMask = ((1 << UPM11) | (1 << UPM10)); + break; + case CDC_PARITY_Even: + ConfigMask = (1 << UPM11); + break; + } + + if (CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.CharFormat == CDC_LINEENCODING_TwoStopBits) + ConfigMask |= (1 << USBS1); + + switch (CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.DataBits) + { + case 6: + ConfigMask |= (1 << UCSZ10); + break; + case 7: + ConfigMask |= (1 << UCSZ11); + break; + case 8: + ConfigMask |= ((1 << UCSZ11) | (1 << UCSZ10)); + break; + } + + /* Must turn off USART before reconfiguring it, otherwise incorrect operation may occur */ + UCSR1B = 0; + UCSR1A = 0; + UCSR1C = 0; + + /* Set the new baud rate before configuring the USART */ + UBRR1 = SERIAL_2X_UBBRVAL(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.BaudRateBPS); + + /* Reconfigure the USART in double speed mode for a wider baud rate range at the expense of accuracy */ + UCSR1C = ConfigMask; + UCSR1A = (1 << U2X1); + UCSR1B = ((1 << RXCIE1) | (1 << TXEN1) | (1 << RXEN1)); +} + +/** ISR to manage the reception of data from the serial port, placing received bytes into a circular buffer + * for later transmission to the host. + */ +ISR(USART1_RX_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + uint8_t ReceivedByte = UDR1; + + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + RingBuffer_Insert(&USARTtoUSB_Buffer, ReceivedByte); +} + +/** Event handler for the CDC Class driver Host-to-Device Line Encoding Changed event. + * + * \param[in] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to the CDC class interface configuration structure being referenced + */ +void EVENT_CDC_Device_ControLineStateChanged(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + static bool PreviousDTRState = false; + bool CurrentDTRState = (CDCInterfaceInfo->State.ControlLineStates.HostToDevice & CDC_CONTROL_LINE_OUT_DTR); + + /* Check if the DTR line has been asserted - if so, start the target AVR's reset pulse */ + if (!(PreviousDTRState) && CurrentDTRState) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_BUSY); + + AVR_RESET_LINE_DDR |= AVR_RESET_LINE_MASK; + PulseMSRemaining.ResetPulse = AVR_RESET_PULSE_MS; + } + + PreviousDTRState = CurrentDTRState; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Benito.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Benito.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..28bed26afa --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Benito.h @@ -0,0 +1,79 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Benito.c. + */ + +#ifndef _BENITO_H_ +#define _BENITO_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/RingBuffer.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate TX activity. */ + #define LEDMASK_TX LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate RX activity. */ + #define LEDMASK_RX LEDS_LED2 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_BUSY (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + + void EVENT_CDC_Device_LineEncodingChanged(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo); + void EVENT_CDC_Device_ControLineStateChanged(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Benito.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Benito.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..07bec52b3a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Benito.txt @@ -0,0 +1,106 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Benito Arduino Programmer Project + * + * \section Sec_Compat Project Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this project. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this project. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Abstract Control Model (ACM)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF CDC Class Standard \n + * Arduino Bootloader Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Firmware for a USB AVR powered programmer for Arduino boards using the official Arduino bootloader. This + * project acts like a regular USB to Serial bridge, except that asserting the DTR line will cause a pulse + * to appear on a given port pin, to control the target's /RESET pin. + * + * This is primarily designed to fit the Benito board from www.dorkbotpdx.org, but will suit all USB AVRs. + * + * After running this project for the first time on a new computer, you will need to supply the .INF file located + * in this project's directory as the device's driver when running under Windows. This will enable Windows to use + * its inbuilt CDC drivers, negating the need for custom drivers for the device. Other Operating Systems should + * automatically use their own inbuilt CDC-ACM drivers. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this project, which can control the project behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AVR_RESET_LINE_PORT</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Indicates the PORT register of the pin used to generate the target /RESET line pulse.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AVR_RESET_LINE_DDR</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Indicates the DDR register of the pin used to generate the target /RESET line pulse.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AVR_RESET_LINE_MASK</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Indicates the mask of the pin used to generate the target /RESET line pulse.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>AVR_RESET_PULSE_MS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Pulse length in milliseconds for the target /RESET pulse.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>TX_RX_LED_PULSE_MS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Pulse length in milliseconds for the activity Tx/Rx LEDs.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>PING_PONG_LED_PULSE_MS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Pulse length in milliseconds for the enumeration LED ping-ponging between toggles.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>RECEIVE_BUFFER_FLUSH_MS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Period between flushings of received data buffer to the attached USB host.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3d81c45b05 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,57 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define AVR_RESET_LINE_PORT PORTD + #define AVR_RESET_LINE_DDR DDRD + #define AVR_RESET_LINE_MASK (1 << 4) + + #define AVR_RESET_PULSE_MS 10 + + #define TX_RX_LED_PULSE_MS 30 + #define PING_PONG_LED_PULSE_MS 100 + + #define RECEIVE_BUFFER_FLUSH_MS 10 + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6b113c8276 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 + #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..86cfa9a8e8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,244 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2060, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .CDC_CCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Header = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .CDCSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + }, + + .CDC_Functional_ACM = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ACM, + + .Capabilities = 0x06, + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Union = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Union, + + .MasterInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .SlaveInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + }, + + .CDC_NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0xFF + }, + + .CDC_DCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .CDC_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Benito Arduino Programmer"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..453bb74cad --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,112 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 2) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_TX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define CDC_RX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE 8 + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC data IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE 16 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // CDC Command Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_CCI_Interface; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t CDC_Functional_Header; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t CDC_Functional_ACM; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t CDC_Functional_Union; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_NotificationEndpoint; + + // CDC Data Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_DCI_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataOutEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataInEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI = 0, /**< CDC CCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI = 1, /**< CDC DCI interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/LUFA Benito Programmer.inf b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/LUFA Benito Programmer.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..75e93a8a9a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/LUFA Benito Programmer.inf @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +;************************************************************ +; Windows USB CDC ACM Setup File +; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation +;************************************************************ + +[DefaultInstall] +CopyINF="LUFA Benito Programmer.inf" + +[Version] +Signature="$Windows NT$" +Class=Ports +ClassGuid={4D36E978-E325-11CE-BFC1-08002BE10318} +Provider=%MFGNAME% +DriverVer=7/1/2012,10.0.0.0 + +[Manufacturer] +%MFGNAME%=DeviceList, NTx86, NTamd64, NTia64 + +[SourceDisksNames] + +[SourceDisksFiles] + +[DestinationDirs] +DefaultDestDir=12 + +[DriverInstall] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +CopyFiles=FakeModemCopyFileSection +AddReg=DriverInstall.AddReg + +[DriverInstall.Services] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +AddService=usbser, 0x00000002, LowerFilter_Service_Inst + +[DriverInstall.AddReg] +HKR,,EnumPropPages32,,"msports.dll,SerialPortPropPageProvider" + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; Vendor and Product ID Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; When developing your USB device, the VID and PID used in the PC side +; application program and the firmware on the microcontroller must match. +; Modify the below line to use your VID and PID. Use the format as shown below. +; Note: One INF file can be used for multiple devices with different VID and PIDs. +; For each supported device, append ",USB\VID_xxxx&PID_yyyy" to the end of the line. +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[DeviceList] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2060 + +[DeviceList.NTx86] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2060 + +[DeviceList.NTamd64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2060 + +[DeviceList.NTia64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2060 + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; String Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +;Modify these strings to customize your device +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[Strings] +MFGNAME="http://www.lufa-lib.org" +DESCRIPTION="LUFA Benito Programmer"
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6f36da7671 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,53 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Benito Programmer" id="lufa.projects.benito.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.projects.benito"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="usbkey"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="8000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="8000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.projects.benito" caption="Benito Programmer">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Benito AVR programmer.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="CDC Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="Benito.txt"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="LUFA Benito Programmer.inf"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Benito.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Benito.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ringbuffer"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dff1b73f1c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "Benito Arduino Programmer Project" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/makefile b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e44ffef936 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Benito/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = atmega32u2 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = BENITO +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = Benito +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..197122fce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/HIDReportViewer.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/HIDReportViewer.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e580caa478 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/HIDReportViewer.c @@ -0,0 +1,325 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the HIDReportViewer project. This file contains the main tasks of + * the project and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "HIDReportViewer.h" + +/** Processed HID report descriptor items structure, containing information on each HID report element */ +static HID_ReportInfo_t HIDReportInfo; + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Host_t Device_HID_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .DataINPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .HIDInterfaceProtocol = HID_CSCP_NonBootProtocol, + .HIDParserData = &HIDReportInfo + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + puts_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_CYAN "HID Device Report Viewer Running.\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + RetrieveDeviceData(); + + HID_Host_USBTask(&Device_HID_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Task to retrieve the HID device information from an attached device, and output + * the relevant data to the serial port for analysis. + */ +void RetrieveDeviceData(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + + OutputReportSizes(); + OutputParsedReportItems(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); +} + +/** Prints a summary of the device's HID report sizes from the HID parser output to the serial port + * for display to the user. + */ +void OutputReportSizes(void) +{ + printf_P(PSTR("\r\n\r\nTotal Device Reports: %" PRId8 "\r\n"), HIDReportInfo.TotalDeviceReports); + + for (uint8_t ReportIndex = 0; ReportIndex < HIDReportInfo.TotalDeviceReports; ReportIndex++) + { + const HID_ReportSizeInfo_t* CurrReportIDInfo = &HIDReportInfo.ReportIDSizes[ReportIndex]; + + uint8_t ReportSizeInBits = CurrReportIDInfo->ReportSizeBits[HID_REPORT_ITEM_In]; + uint8_t ReportSizeOutBits = CurrReportIDInfo->ReportSizeBits[HID_REPORT_ITEM_Out]; + uint8_t ReportSizeFeatureBits = CurrReportIDInfo->ReportSizeBits[HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature]; + + /* Print out the byte sizes of each report within the device */ + printf_P(PSTR(" + Report ID 0x%02" PRIX8 "\r\n" + " - Input Data: %" PRId8 " bits (%" PRId8 " bytes)\r\n" + " - Output Data: %" PRId8 " bits (%" PRId8 " bytes)\r\n" + " - Feature Data: %" PRId8 " bits (%" PRId8 " bytes)\r\n"), + CurrReportIDInfo->ReportID, + ReportSizeInBits, + ((ReportSizeInBits >> 3) + ((ReportSizeInBits & 0x07) != 0)), + ReportSizeOutBits, + ((ReportSizeOutBits >> 3) + ((ReportSizeOutBits & 0x07) != 0)), + ReportSizeFeatureBits, + ((ReportSizeFeatureBits >> 3) + ((ReportSizeFeatureBits & 0x07) != 0))); + } +} + +/** Prints a summary of the device's parsed and stored report items along with their attributes + * to the serial port for display to the user. + */ +void OutputParsedReportItems(void) +{ + printf_P(PSTR("\r\nReport Items (%" PRId8 " in Table):\r\n"), HIDReportInfo.TotalReportItems); + + for (uint8_t ItemIndex = 0; ItemIndex < HIDReportInfo.TotalReportItems; ItemIndex++) + { + const HID_ReportItem_t* RItem = &HIDReportInfo.ReportItems[ItemIndex]; + + printf_P(PSTR(" + Item %" PRId8 ":\r\n" + " - Report ID: 0x%02" PRIX8 "\r\n" + " - Data Direction: %s\r\n" + " - Item Flags: 0x%02" PRIX8 "\r\n" + " - Item Offset (Bits): 0x%02" PRIX8 "\r\n" + " - Item Size (Bits): 0x%02" PRIX8 "\r\n" + " - Usage Page: 0x%04" PRIX16 "\r\n" + " - Usage: 0x%04" PRIX16 "\r\n" + " - Unit Type: 0x%08" PRIX32 "\r\n" + " - Unit Exponent: 0x%02" PRIX8 "\r\n" + " - Logical Minimum: 0x%08" PRIX32 "\r\n" + " - Logical Maximum: 0x%08" PRIX32 "\r\n" + " - Physical Minimum: 0x%08" PRIX32 "\r\n" + " - Physical Maximum: 0x%08" PRIX32 "\r\n" + " - Collection Path:\r\n"), + ItemIndex, + RItem->ReportID, + ((RItem->ItemType == HID_REPORT_ITEM_In) ? "IN" : ((RItem->ItemType == HID_REPORT_ITEM_Out) ? "OUT" : "FEATURE")), + RItem->ItemFlags, + RItem->BitOffset, + RItem->Attributes.BitSize, + RItem->Attributes.Usage.Page, + RItem->Attributes.Usage.Usage, + RItem->Attributes.Unit.Type, + RItem->Attributes.Unit.Exponent, + RItem->Attributes.Logical.Minimum, + RItem->Attributes.Logical.Maximum, + RItem->Attributes.Physical.Minimum, + RItem->Attributes.Physical.Maximum); + + OutputCollectionPath(RItem->CollectionPath); + } +} + +/** Prints the HID Collection path (along with each node's attributes) to the serial port + * for display to the user, from the given starting node to the root node. + * + * \param[in] CollectionPath Starting HID Collection node to print + */ +void OutputCollectionPath(const HID_CollectionPath_t* const CollectionPath) +{ + const HID_CollectionPath_t* CurrentNode = CollectionPath; + + while (CurrentNode != NULL) + { + printf_P(PSTR(" |\r\n" + " - Type: 0x%02" PRIX8 "\r\n" + " - Usage: 0x%02" PRIX8 "\r\n"), + CurrentNode->Type, CurrentNode->Usage); + + CurrentNode = CurrentNode->Parent; + } + + printf_P(PSTR(" |\r\n" + " END\r\n")); +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Serial_Init(9600, false); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Create a stdio stream for the serial port for stdin and stdout */ + Serial_CreateStream(NULL); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("Device Attached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + puts_P(PSTR("\r\nDevice Unattached.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize; + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData, + sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData)) != HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Retrieving Configuration Descriptor.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (HID_Host_ConfigurePipes(&Device_HID_Interface, + ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData) != HID_ENUMERROR_NoError) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Attached Device Not a Valid HID Device.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Device Configuration.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (HID_Host_SetReportProtocol(&Device_HID_Interface) != 0) + { + puts_P(PSTR("Error Setting Report Protocol Mode.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + puts_P(PSTR("HID Device Enumerated.\r\n")); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Host Mode Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + printf_P(PSTR(ESC_FG_RED "Dev Enum Error\r\n" + " -- Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- Sub Error Code %d\r\n" + " -- In State %d\r\n" ESC_FG_WHITE), ErrorCode, SubErrorCode, USB_HostState); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Callback for the HID Report Parser. This function is called each time the HID report parser is about to store + * an IN, OUT or FEATURE item into the HIDReportInfo structure. To save on RAM, we are able to filter out items + * we aren't interested in (preventing us from being able to extract them later on, but saving on the RAM they would + * have occupied). + * + * \param[in] CurrentItem Pointer to the item the HID report parser is currently working with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the item should be stored into the HID report structure, \c false if it should be discarded + */ +bool CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem(HID_ReportItem_t* const CurrentItem) +{ + return true; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/HIDReportViewer.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/HIDReportViewer.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..22224fe1a4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/HIDReportViewer.h @@ -0,0 +1,87 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for HIDReportViewer.c. + */ + +#ifndef _HID_REPORT_VIEWER_H_ +#define _HID_REPORT_VIEWER_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + #include <inttypes.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void RetrieveDeviceData(void); + void OutputReportSizes(void); + void OutputParsedReportItems(void); + void OutputCollectionPath(const HID_CollectionPath_t* const CollectionPath); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + + bool CALLBACK_HIDParser_FilterHIDReportItem(HID_ReportItem_t* const CurrentItem); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/HIDReportViewer.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/HIDReportViewer.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fccc892c6c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/HIDReportViewer.txt @@ -0,0 +1,64 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage HID Device Report Viewer Programmer Project + * + * \section Sec_Compat Project Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this project. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this project. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Firmware for a HID Report viewer. This project is designed to aid in the debugging of USB HID Hosts, where the contents of an + * unknown HID device's HID Report need to be examined. Once a HID device has been plugged into this application, the HID report + * descriptor will be parsed using the internal LUFA HID report parser, and the results dumped to the serial port in a human + * readable format. This output will contain information on the sizes of the reports within the device's HID interface, as well as + * information on each report element (size, usage, minimum/maximum values, etc.). + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this project, which can control the project behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7819aabf87 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="HID Report Viewer" id="lufa.projects.hid_viewer.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.projects.hid_viewer"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="usbkey"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="8000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="8000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.projects.hid_viewer" caption="HID Report Viewer">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ HID device report viewer project.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="HIDReportViewer.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="HIDReportViewer.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="HIDReportViewer.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ansi"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..015e9c0f6a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "HID Device Report Viewer Project" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/makefile b/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..75d40e88c0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/HIDReportViewer/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = HIDReportViewer +SRC = $(TARGET).c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/CPUMonitor.Designer.cs b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/CPUMonitor.Designer.cs new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2b189943a7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/CPUMonitor.Designer.cs @@ -0,0 +1,131 @@ +namespace CPUMonitor +{ + partial class frmCPU + { + /// <summary> + /// Required designer variable. + /// </summary> + private System.ComponentModel.IContainer components = null; + + /// <summary> + /// Clean up any resources being used. + /// </summary> + /// <param name="disposing">true if managed resources should be disposed; otherwise, false.</param> + protected override void Dispose(bool disposing) + { + if (disposing && (components != null)) + { + components.Dispose(); + } + base.Dispose(disposing); + } + + #region Windows Form Designer generated code + + /// <summary> + /// Required method for Designer support - do not modify + /// the contents of this method with the code editor. + /// </summary> + private void InitializeComponent() + { + this.components = new System.ComponentModel.Container(); + this.serSerialPort = new System.IO.Ports.SerialPort(this.components); + this.tmrCPUTimer = new System.Windows.Forms.Timer(this.components); + this.cmbComPort = new System.Windows.Forms.ComboBox(); + this.pcCPUUsage = new System.Diagnostics.PerformanceCounter(); + this.lblCPU = new System.Windows.Forms.Label(); + this.nicoNotifyIcon = new System.Windows.Forms.NotifyIcon(this.components); + this.btnMinimizeToTray = new System.Windows.Forms.Button(); + this.btnExit = new System.Windows.Forms.Button(); + ((System.ComponentModel.ISupportInitialize)(this.pcCPUUsage)).BeginInit(); + this.SuspendLayout(); + // + // tmrCPUTimer + // + this.tmrCPUTimer.Enabled = true; + this.tmrCPUTimer.Interval = 1000; + this.tmrCPUTimer.Tick += new System.EventHandler(this.tmrCPUTimer_Tick); + // + // cmbComPort + // + this.cmbComPort.FormattingEnabled = true; + this.cmbComPort.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(48, 12); + this.cmbComPort.Name = "cmbComPort"; + this.cmbComPort.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(156, 21); + this.cmbComPort.TabIndex = 0; + this.cmbComPort.SelectedIndexChanged += new System.EventHandler(this.cbPort_SelectedIndexChanged); + // + // pcCPUUsage + // + this.pcCPUUsage.CategoryName = "Processor"; + this.pcCPUUsage.CounterName = "% Processor Time"; + this.pcCPUUsage.InstanceName = "_Total"; + // + // lblCPU + // + this.lblCPU.Font = new System.Drawing.Font("Microsoft Sans Serif", 14.25F, System.Drawing.FontStyle.Bold, System.Drawing.GraphicsUnit.Point, ((byte)(0))); + this.lblCPU.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(44, 36); + this.lblCPU.Name = "lblCPU"; + this.lblCPU.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(160, 28); + this.lblCPU.TabIndex = 1; + this.lblCPU.Text = "0%"; + this.lblCPU.TextAlign = System.Drawing.ContentAlignment.MiddleCenter; + // + // nicoNotifyIcon + // + this.nicoNotifyIcon.Text = "CPU Usage Monitor"; + this.nicoNotifyIcon.Visible = true; + // + // btnMinimizeToTray + // + this.btnMinimizeToTray.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(12, 67); + this.btnMinimizeToTray.Name = "btnMinimizeToTray"; + this.btnMinimizeToTray.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(111, 28); + this.btnMinimizeToTray.TabIndex = 2; + this.btnMinimizeToTray.Text = "Minimize to Tray"; + this.btnMinimizeToTray.UseVisualStyleBackColor = true; + this.btnMinimizeToTray.Click += new System.EventHandler(this.btnMinimizeToTray_Click); + // + // btnExit + // + this.btnExit.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(126, 67); + this.btnExit.Name = "btnExit"; + this.btnExit.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(111, 28); + this.btnExit.TabIndex = 3; + this.btnExit.Text = "Exit"; + this.btnExit.UseVisualStyleBackColor = true; + this.btnExit.Click += new System.EventHandler(this.btnExit_Click); + // + // frmCPU + // + this.AutoScaleDimensions = new System.Drawing.SizeF(6F, 13F); + this.AutoScaleMode = System.Windows.Forms.AutoScaleMode.Font; + this.ClientSize = new System.Drawing.Size(249, 106); + this.Controls.Add(this.btnExit); + this.Controls.Add(this.btnMinimizeToTray); + this.Controls.Add(this.lblCPU); + this.Controls.Add(this.cmbComPort); + this.FormBorderStyle = System.Windows.Forms.FormBorderStyle.FixedSingle; + this.MaximizeBox = false; + this.Name = "frmCPU"; + this.Text = "CPU Usage Monitor"; + this.WindowState = System.Windows.Forms.FormWindowState.Minimized; + this.Load += new System.EventHandler(this.Form1_Load); + ((System.ComponentModel.ISupportInitialize)(this.pcCPUUsage)).EndInit(); + this.ResumeLayout(false); + + } + + #endregion + + private System.IO.Ports.SerialPort serSerialPort; + private System.Windows.Forms.Timer tmrCPUTimer; + private System.Windows.Forms.ComboBox cmbComPort; + private System.Diagnostics.PerformanceCounter pcCPUUsage; + private System.Windows.Forms.Label lblCPU; + private System.Windows.Forms.NotifyIcon nicoNotifyIcon; + private System.Windows.Forms.Button btnMinimizeToTray; + private System.Windows.Forms.Button btnExit; + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/CPUMonitor.cs b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/CPUMonitor.cs new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..32543fc59b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/CPUMonitor.cs @@ -0,0 +1,115 @@ +using System; +using System.Collections.Generic; +using System.ComponentModel; +using System.Data; +using System.Drawing; +using System.Linq; +using System.Text; +using System.Windows.Forms; +using Microsoft.Win32; + +namespace CPUMonitor +{ + public partial class frmCPU : Form + { + private RegistryKey AppRegKey; + + private const int LIGHT_MAX = 0x1F; + + public frmCPU() + { + InitializeComponent(); + + nicoNotifyIcon.Icon = this.Icon; + nicoNotifyIcon.MouseClick += new MouseEventHandler(TrayIconClick); + } + + private void Form1_Load(object sender, EventArgs e) + { + AppRegKey = Registry.CurrentUser.CreateSubKey("Software\\CPUMonitor"); + + String[] PortNames = System.IO.Ports.SerialPort.GetPortNames(); + Array.Sort<String>(PortNames, delegate(string strA, string strB) { return int.Parse(strA.Substring(3)).CompareTo(int.Parse(strB.Substring(3))); }); + cmbComPort.Items.Clear(); + cmbComPort.Items.AddRange(PortNames); + + cmbComPort.SelectedIndex = System.Convert.ToInt32(AppRegKey.GetValue("Port", "1")) - 1; + serSerialPort.PortName = cmbComPort.Text; + + Hide(); + } + + private void NotifyLight(int Red, int Green, int Blue) + { + byte[] buffer = new byte[3]; + buffer[0] = (byte)(0x80 | (Red & LIGHT_MAX)); + buffer[1] = (byte)(0x40 | (Green & LIGHT_MAX)); + buffer[2] = (byte)(0x20 | (Blue & LIGHT_MAX)); + + try + { + serSerialPort.PortName = cmbComPort.Text; + serSerialPort.Open(); + serSerialPort.Write(buffer, 0, buffer.Length); + serSerialPort.Close(); + } + catch (Exception e) + { + + } + } + + private void tmrCPUTimer_Tick(object sender, EventArgs e) + { + float CPUUsage = pcCPUUsage.NextValue(); + + int Red = 0; + int Green = 0; + int Blue = 0; + + if (CPUUsage < 25) + { + Green = (int)((LIGHT_MAX / 25) * CPUUsage); + } + else if (CPUUsage < 50) + { + Blue = (int)((LIGHT_MAX / 25) * (CPUUsage - 25)); + Green = LIGHT_MAX - Blue; + } + else if (CPUUsage < 75) + { + Red = (int)((LIGHT_MAX / 25) * (CPUUsage - 50)); + Blue = LIGHT_MAX - Red; + } + else + { + Red = LIGHT_MAX; + } + + NotifyLight(Red, Green, Blue); + lblCPU.Text = ((int)CPUUsage).ToString() + "%"; + } + + private void btnExit_Click(object sender, EventArgs e) + { + Application.Exit(); + } + + private void btnMinimizeToTray_Click(object sender, EventArgs e) + { + this.Hide(); + } + + private void TrayIconClick(object sender, MouseEventArgs e) + { + this.Show(); + this.WindowState = FormWindowState.Normal; + } + + private void cbPort_SelectedIndexChanged(object sender, EventArgs e) + { + AppRegKey.SetValue("Port", cmbComPort.SelectedIndex + 1); + serSerialPort.PortName = cmbComPort.Text; + } + } +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/CPUMonitor.csproj b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/CPUMonitor.csproj new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d568a9dc48 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/CPUMonitor.csproj @@ -0,0 +1,95 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?> +<Project ToolsVersion="4.0" DefaultTargets="Build" xmlns="http://schemas.microsoft.com/developer/msbuild/2003"> + <PropertyGroup> + <Configuration Condition=" '$(Configuration)' == '' ">Debug</Configuration> + <Platform Condition=" '$(Platform)' == '' ">AnyCPU</Platform> + <ProductVersion>9.0.21022</ProductVersion> + <SchemaVersion>2.0</SchemaVersion> + <ProjectGuid>{6040B049-4241-4FFD-B388-AACDA78D1469}</ProjectGuid> + <OutputType>WinExe</OutputType> + <AppDesignerFolder>Properties</AppDesignerFolder> + <RootNamespace>CPUMonitor</RootNamespace> + <AssemblyName>CPUMonitor</AssemblyName> + <TargetFrameworkVersion>v3.5</TargetFrameworkVersion> + <FileAlignment>512</FileAlignment> + <FileUpgradeFlags> + </FileUpgradeFlags> + <OldToolsVersion>3.5</OldToolsVersion> + <UpgradeBackupLocation /> + </PropertyGroup> + <PropertyGroup Condition=" '$(Configuration)|$(Platform)' == 'Debug|AnyCPU' "> + <DebugSymbols>true</DebugSymbols> + <DebugType>full</DebugType> + <Optimize>false</Optimize> + <OutputPath>bin\Debug\</OutputPath> + <DefineConstants>DEBUG;TRACE</DefineConstants> + <ErrorReport>prompt</ErrorReport> + <WarningLevel>4</WarningLevel> + </PropertyGroup> + <PropertyGroup Condition=" '$(Configuration)|$(Platform)' == 'Release|AnyCPU' "> + <DebugType>pdbonly</DebugType> + <Optimize>true</Optimize> + <OutputPath>bin\Release\</OutputPath> + <DefineConstants>TRACE</DefineConstants> + <ErrorReport>prompt</ErrorReport> + <WarningLevel>4</WarningLevel> + </PropertyGroup> + <ItemGroup> + <Reference Include="System" /> + <Reference Include="System.Core"> + <RequiredTargetFramework>3.5</RequiredTargetFramework> + </Reference> + <Reference Include="System.Xml.Linq"> + <RequiredTargetFramework>3.5</RequiredTargetFramework> + </Reference> + <Reference Include="System.Data.DataSetExtensions"> + <RequiredTargetFramework>3.5</RequiredTargetFramework> + </Reference> + <Reference Include="System.Data" /> + <Reference Include="System.Deployment" /> + <Reference Include="System.Drawing" /> + <Reference Include="System.Windows.Forms" /> + <Reference Include="System.Xml" /> + </ItemGroup> + <ItemGroup> + <Compile Include="CPUMonitor.cs"> + <SubType>Form</SubType> + </Compile> + <Compile Include="CPUMonitor.Designer.cs"> + <DependentUpon>CPUMonitor.cs</DependentUpon> + </Compile> + <Compile Include="Program.cs" /> + <Compile Include="Properties\AssemblyInfo.cs" /> + <EmbeddedResource Include="CPUMonitor.resx"> + <DependentUpon>CPUMonitor.cs</DependentUpon> + <SubType>Designer</SubType> + </EmbeddedResource> + <EmbeddedResource Include="Properties\Resources.resx"> + <Generator>ResXFileCodeGenerator</Generator> + <LastGenOutput>Resources.Designer.cs</LastGenOutput> + <SubType>Designer</SubType> + </EmbeddedResource> + <Compile Include="Properties\Resources.Designer.cs"> + <AutoGen>True</AutoGen> + <DependentUpon>Resources.resx</DependentUpon> + <DesignTime>True</DesignTime> + </Compile> + <None Include="Properties\Settings.settings"> + <Generator>SettingsSingleFileGenerator</Generator> + <LastGenOutput>Settings.Designer.cs</LastGenOutput> + </None> + <Compile Include="Properties\Settings.Designer.cs"> + <AutoGen>True</AutoGen> + <DependentUpon>Settings.settings</DependentUpon> + <DesignTimeSharedInput>True</DesignTimeSharedInput> + </Compile> + </ItemGroup> + <Import Project="$(MSBuildToolsPath)\Microsoft.CSharp.targets" /> + <!-- To modify your build process, add your task inside one of the targets below and uncomment it. + Other similar extension points exist, see Microsoft.Common.targets. + <Target Name="BeforeBuild"> + </Target> + <Target Name="AfterBuild"> + </Target> + --> +</Project>
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/CPUMonitor.resx b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/CPUMonitor.resx new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c62b1b0203 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/CPUMonitor.resx @@ -0,0 +1,132 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?> +<root> + <!-- + Microsoft ResX Schema + + Version 2.0 + + The primary goals of this format is to allow a simple XML format + that is mostly human readable. The generation and parsing of the + various data types are done through the TypeConverter classes + associated with the data types. + + Example: + + ... ado.net/XML headers & schema ... + <resheader name="resmimetype">text/microsoft-resx</resheader> + <resheader name="version">2.0</resheader> + <resheader name="reader">System.Resources.ResXResourceReader, System.Windows.Forms, ...</resheader> + <resheader name="writer">System.Resources.ResXResourceWriter, System.Windows.Forms, ...</resheader> + <data name="Name1"><value>this is my long string</value><comment>this is a comment</comment></data> + <data name="Color1" type="System.Drawing.Color, System.Drawing">Blue</data> + <data name="Bitmap1" mimetype="application/x-microsoft.net.object.binary.base64"> + <value>[base64 mime encoded serialized .NET Framework object]</value> + </data> + <data name="Icon1" type="System.Drawing.Icon, System.Drawing" mimetype="application/x-microsoft.net.object.bytearray.base64"> + <value>[base64 mime encoded string representing a byte array form of the .NET Framework object]</value> + <comment>This is a comment</comment> + </data> + + There are any number of "resheader" rows that contain simple + name/value pairs. + + Each data row contains a name, and value. The row also contains a + type or mimetype. Type corresponds to a .NET class that support + text/value conversion through the TypeConverter architecture. + Classes that don't support this are serialized and stored with the + mimetype set. + + The mimetype is used for serialized objects, and tells the + ResXResourceReader how to depersist the object. This is currently not + extensible. For a given mimetype the value must be set accordingly: + + Note - application/x-microsoft.net.object.binary.base64 is the format + that the ResXResourceWriter will generate, however the reader can + read any of the formats listed below. + + mimetype: application/x-microsoft.net.object.binary.base64 + value : The object must be serialized with + : System.Runtime.Serialization.Formatters.Binary.BinaryFormatter + : and then encoded with base64 encoding. + + mimetype: application/x-microsoft.net.object.soap.base64 + value : The object must be serialized with + : System.Runtime.Serialization.Formatters.Soap.SoapFormatter + : and then encoded with base64 encoding. + + mimetype: application/x-microsoft.net.object.bytearray.base64 + value : The object must be serialized into a byte array + : using a System.ComponentModel.TypeConverter + : and then encoded with base64 encoding. + --> + <xsd:schema id="root" xmlns="" xmlns:xsd="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema" xmlns:msdata="urn:schemas-microsoft-com:xml-msdata"> + <xsd:import namespace="http://www.w3.org/XML/1998/namespace" /> + <xsd:element name="root" msdata:IsDataSet="true"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:choice maxOccurs="unbounded"> + <xsd:element name="metadata"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:sequence> + <xsd:element name="value" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" /> + </xsd:sequence> + <xsd:attribute name="name" use="required" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute name="type" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute name="mimetype" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute ref="xml:space" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + <xsd:element name="assembly"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:attribute name="alias" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + <xsd:element name="data"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:sequence> + <xsd:element name="value" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" msdata:Ordinal="1" /> + <xsd:element name="comment" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" msdata:Ordinal="2" /> + </xsd:sequence> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" use="required" msdata:Ordinal="1" /> + <xsd:attribute name="type" type="xsd:string" msdata:Ordinal="3" /> + <xsd:attribute name="mimetype" type="xsd:string" msdata:Ordinal="4" /> + <xsd:attribute ref="xml:space" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + <xsd:element name="resheader"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:sequence> + <xsd:element name="value" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" msdata:Ordinal="1" /> + </xsd:sequence> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" use="required" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + </xsd:choice> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + </xsd:schema> + <resheader name="resmimetype"> + <value>text/microsoft-resx</value> + </resheader> + <resheader name="version"> + <value>2.0</value> + </resheader> + <resheader name="reader"> + <value>System.Resources.ResXResourceReader, System.Windows.Forms, Version=2.0.0.0, Culture=neutral, PublicKeyToken=b77a5c561934e089</value> + </resheader> + <resheader name="writer"> + <value>System.Resources.ResXResourceWriter, System.Windows.Forms, Version=2.0.0.0, Culture=neutral, PublicKeyToken=b77a5c561934e089</value> + </resheader> + <metadata name="serSerialPort.TrayLocation" type="System.Drawing.Point, System.Drawing, Version=2.0.0.0, Culture=neutral, PublicKeyToken=b03f5f7f11d50a3a"> + <value>17, 17</value> + </metadata> + <metadata name="tmrCPUTimer.TrayLocation" type="System.Drawing.Point, System.Drawing, Version=2.0.0.0, Culture=neutral, PublicKeyToken=b03f5f7f11d50a3a"> + <value>137, 17</value> + </metadata> + <metadata name="pcCPUUsage.TrayLocation" type="System.Drawing.Point, System.Drawing, Version=2.0.0.0, Culture=neutral, PublicKeyToken=b03f5f7f11d50a3a"> + <value>262, 17</value> + </metadata> + <metadata name="nicoNotifyIcon.TrayLocation" type="System.Drawing.Point, System.Drawing, Version=2.0.0.0, Culture=neutral, PublicKeyToken=b03f5f7f11d50a3a"> + <value>383, 17</value> + </metadata> +</root>
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/Program.cs b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/Program.cs new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cb4fd89f23 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/Program.cs @@ -0,0 +1,21 @@ +using System; +using System.Collections.Generic; +using System.Linq; +using System.Windows.Forms; + +namespace CPUMonitor +{ + static class Program + { + /// <summary> + /// The main entry point for the application. + /// </summary> + [STAThread] + static void Main() + { + Application.EnableVisualStyles(); + Application.SetCompatibleTextRenderingDefault(false); + Application.Run(new frmCPU()); + } + } +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/Properties/AssemblyInfo.cs b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/Properties/AssemblyInfo.cs new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..85d31fcba7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/Properties/AssemblyInfo.cs @@ -0,0 +1,36 @@ +using System.Reflection; +using System.Runtime.CompilerServices; +using System.Runtime.InteropServices; + +// General Information about an assembly is controlled through the following +// set of attributes. Change these attribute values to modify the information +// associated with an assembly. +[assembly: AssemblyTitle("CPUMonitor")] +[assembly: AssemblyDescription("")] +[assembly: AssemblyConfiguration("")] +[assembly: AssemblyCompany("Microsoft")] +[assembly: AssemblyProduct("CPUMonitor")] +[assembly: AssemblyCopyright("Copyright © Microsoft 2009")] +[assembly: AssemblyTrademark("")] +[assembly: AssemblyCulture("")] + +// Setting ComVisible to false makes the types in this assembly not visible +// to COM components. If you need to access a type in this assembly from +// COM, set the ComVisible attribute to true on that type. +[assembly: ComVisible(false)] + +// The following GUID is for the ID of the typelib if this project is exposed to COM +[assembly: Guid("3e4a61da-cdde-46de-848b-b5206d225e21")] + +// Version information for an assembly consists of the following four values: +// +// Major Version +// Minor Version +// Build Number +// Revision +// +// You can specify all the values or you can default the Build and Revision Numbers +// by using the '*' as shown below: +// [assembly: AssemblyVersion("1.0.*")] +[assembly: AssemblyVersion("1.0.0.0")] +[assembly: AssemblyFileVersion("1.0.0.0")] diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/Properties/Resources.Designer.cs b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/Properties/Resources.Designer.cs new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bf80e05fc5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/Properties/Resources.Designer.cs @@ -0,0 +1,63 @@ +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +// <auto-generated> +// This code was generated by a tool. +// Runtime Version:4.0.30319.239 +// +// Changes to this file may cause incorrect behavior and will be lost if +// the code is regenerated. +// </auto-generated> +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------ + +namespace CPUMonitor.Properties { + using System; + + + /// <summary> + /// A strongly-typed resource class, for looking up localized strings, etc. + /// </summary> + // This class was auto-generated by the StronglyTypedResourceBuilder + // class via a tool like ResGen or Visual Studio. + // To add or remove a member, edit your .ResX file then rerun ResGen + // with the /str option, or rebuild your VS project. + [global::System.CodeDom.Compiler.GeneratedCodeAttribute("System.Resources.Tools.StronglyTypedResourceBuilder", "4.0.0.0")] + [global::System.Diagnostics.DebuggerNonUserCodeAttribute()] + [global::System.Runtime.CompilerServices.CompilerGeneratedAttribute()] + internal class Resources { + + private static global::System.Resources.ResourceManager resourceMan; + + private static global::System.Globalization.CultureInfo resourceCulture; + + [global::System.Diagnostics.CodeAnalysis.SuppressMessageAttribute("Microsoft.Performance", "CA1811:AvoidUncalledPrivateCode")] + internal Resources() { + } + + /// <summary> + /// Returns the cached ResourceManager instance used by this class. + /// </summary> + [global::System.ComponentModel.EditorBrowsableAttribute(global::System.ComponentModel.EditorBrowsableState.Advanced)] + internal static global::System.Resources.ResourceManager ResourceManager { + get { + if (object.ReferenceEquals(resourceMan, null)) { + global::System.Resources.ResourceManager temp = new global::System.Resources.ResourceManager("CPUMonitor.Properties.Resources", typeof(Resources).Assembly); + resourceMan = temp; + } + return resourceMan; + } + } + + /// <summary> + /// Overrides the current thread's CurrentUICulture property for all + /// resource lookups using this strongly typed resource class. + /// </summary> + [global::System.ComponentModel.EditorBrowsableAttribute(global::System.ComponentModel.EditorBrowsableState.Advanced)] + internal static global::System.Globalization.CultureInfo Culture { + get { + return resourceCulture; + } + set { + resourceCulture = value; + } + } + } +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/Properties/Resources.resx b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/Properties/Resources.resx new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..af7dbebbac --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/Properties/Resources.resx @@ -0,0 +1,117 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?> +<root> + <!-- + Microsoft ResX Schema + + Version 2.0 + + The primary goals of this format is to allow a simple XML format + that is mostly human readable. The generation and parsing of the + various data types are done through the TypeConverter classes + associated with the data types. + + Example: + + ... ado.net/XML headers & schema ... + <resheader name="resmimetype">text/microsoft-resx</resheader> + <resheader name="version">2.0</resheader> + <resheader name="reader">System.Resources.ResXResourceReader, System.Windows.Forms, ...</resheader> + <resheader name="writer">System.Resources.ResXResourceWriter, System.Windows.Forms, ...</resheader> + <data name="Name1"><value>this is my long string</value><comment>this is a comment</comment></data> + <data name="Color1" type="System.Drawing.Color, System.Drawing">Blue</data> + <data name="Bitmap1" mimetype="application/x-microsoft.net.object.binary.base64"> + <value>[base64 mime encoded serialized .NET Framework object]</value> + </data> + <data name="Icon1" type="System.Drawing.Icon, System.Drawing" mimetype="application/x-microsoft.net.object.bytearray.base64"> + <value>[base64 mime encoded string representing a byte array form of the .NET Framework object]</value> + <comment>This is a comment</comment> + </data> + + There are any number of "resheader" rows that contain simple + name/value pairs. + + Each data row contains a name, and value. The row also contains a + type or mimetype. Type corresponds to a .NET class that support + text/value conversion through the TypeConverter architecture. + Classes that don't support this are serialized and stored with the + mimetype set. + + The mimetype is used for serialized objects, and tells the + ResXResourceReader how to depersist the object. This is currently not + extensible. For a given mimetype the value must be set accordingly: + + Note - application/x-microsoft.net.object.binary.base64 is the format + that the ResXResourceWriter will generate, however the reader can + read any of the formats listed below. + + mimetype: application/x-microsoft.net.object.binary.base64 + value : The object must be serialized with + : System.Serialization.Formatters.Binary.BinaryFormatter + : and then encoded with base64 encoding. + + mimetype: application/x-microsoft.net.object.soap.base64 + value : The object must be serialized with + : System.Runtime.Serialization.Formatters.Soap.SoapFormatter + : and then encoded with base64 encoding. + + mimetype: application/x-microsoft.net.object.bytearray.base64 + value : The object must be serialized into a byte array + : using a System.ComponentModel.TypeConverter + : and then encoded with base64 encoding. + --> + <xsd:schema id="root" xmlns="" xmlns:xsd="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema" xmlns:msdata="urn:schemas-microsoft-com:xml-msdata"> + <xsd:element name="root" msdata:IsDataSet="true"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:choice maxOccurs="unbounded"> + <xsd:element name="metadata"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:sequence> + <xsd:element name="value" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" /> + </xsd:sequence> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute name="type" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute name="mimetype" type="xsd:string" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + <xsd:element name="assembly"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:attribute name="alias" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + <xsd:element name="data"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:sequence> + <xsd:element name="value" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" msdata:Ordinal="1" /> + <xsd:element name="comment" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" msdata:Ordinal="2" /> + </xsd:sequence> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" msdata:Ordinal="1" /> + <xsd:attribute name="type" type="xsd:string" msdata:Ordinal="3" /> + <xsd:attribute name="mimetype" type="xsd:string" msdata:Ordinal="4" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + <xsd:element name="resheader"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:sequence> + <xsd:element name="value" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" msdata:Ordinal="1" /> + </xsd:sequence> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" use="required" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + </xsd:choice> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + </xsd:schema> + <resheader name="resmimetype"> + <value>text/microsoft-resx</value> + </resheader> + <resheader name="version"> + <value>2.0</value> + </resheader> + <resheader name="reader"> + <value>System.Resources.ResXResourceReader, System.Windows.Forms, Version=2.0.0.0, Culture=neutral, PublicKeyToken=b77a5c561934e089</value> + </resheader> + <resheader name="writer"> + <value>System.Resources.ResXResourceWriter, System.Windows.Forms, Version=2.0.0.0, Culture=neutral, PublicKeyToken=b77a5c561934e089</value> + </resheader> +</root>
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/Properties/Settings.Designer.cs b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/Properties/Settings.Designer.cs new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..690fde3ba2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/Properties/Settings.Designer.cs @@ -0,0 +1,26 @@ +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +// <auto-generated> +// This code was generated by a tool. +// Runtime Version:4.0.30319.239 +// +// Changes to this file may cause incorrect behavior and will be lost if +// the code is regenerated. +// </auto-generated> +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------ + +namespace CPUMonitor.Properties { + + + [global::System.Runtime.CompilerServices.CompilerGeneratedAttribute()] + [global::System.CodeDom.Compiler.GeneratedCodeAttribute("Microsoft.VisualStudio.Editors.SettingsDesigner.SettingsSingleFileGenerator", "10.0.0.0")] + internal sealed partial class Settings : global::System.Configuration.ApplicationSettingsBase { + + private static Settings defaultInstance = ((Settings)(global::System.Configuration.ApplicationSettingsBase.Synchronized(new Settings()))); + + public static Settings Default { + get { + return defaultInstance; + } + } + } +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/Properties/Settings.settings b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/Properties/Settings.settings new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..39645652af --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/CPUUsageApp/Properties/Settings.settings @@ -0,0 +1,7 @@ +<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?> +<SettingsFile xmlns="http://schemas.microsoft.com/VisualStudio/2004/01/settings" CurrentProfile="(Default)"> + <Profiles> + <Profile Name="(Default)" /> + </Profiles> + <Settings /> +</SettingsFile> diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..75713f94d0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 + #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..31e6b44b64 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,245 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2044, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .CDC_CCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Header = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .CDCSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + }, + + .CDC_Functional_ACM = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ACM, + + .Capabilities = 0x06, + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Union = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Union, + + .MasterInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .SlaveInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + }, + + .CDC_NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0xFF + }, + + .CDC_DCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .CDC_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LED Notifier"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b19682a2b6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,110 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 2) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_TX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define CDC_RX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE 8 + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC data IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE 16 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // CDC Command Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_CCI_Interface; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t CDC_Functional_Header; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t CDC_Functional_ACM; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t CDC_Functional_Union; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_NotificationEndpoint; + + // CDC Data Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_DCI_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataOutEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataInEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI = 0, /**< CDC CCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI = 1, /**< CDC DCI interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/LEDMixer.Designer.cs b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/LEDMixer.Designer.cs new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..595083a4a8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/LEDMixer.Designer.cs @@ -0,0 +1,149 @@ +namespace LEDMixer +{ + partial class LEDMixer + { + /// <summary> + /// Required designer variable. + /// </summary> + private System.ComponentModel.IContainer components = null; + + /// <summary> + /// Clean up any resources being used. + /// </summary> + /// <param name="disposing">true if managed resources should be disposed; otherwise, false.</param> + protected override void Dispose(bool disposing) + { + if (disposing && (components != null)) + { + components.Dispose(); + } + base.Dispose(disposing); + } + + #region Windows Form Designer generated code + + /// <summary> + /// Required method for Designer support - do not modify + /// the contents of this method with the code editor. + /// </summary> + private void InitializeComponent() + { + this.components = new System.ComponentModel.Container(); + this.tbRed = new System.Windows.Forms.TrackBar(); + this.tbGreen = new System.Windows.Forms.TrackBar(); + this.tbBlue = new System.Windows.Forms.TrackBar(); + this.serSerialPort = new System.IO.Ports.SerialPort(this.components); + this.cbPort = new System.Windows.Forms.ComboBox(); + this.lblRed = new System.Windows.Forms.Label(); + this.lblBlue = new System.Windows.Forms.Label(); + this.lblGreen = new System.Windows.Forms.Label(); + ((System.ComponentModel.ISupportInitialize)(this.tbRed)).BeginInit(); + ((System.ComponentModel.ISupportInitialize)(this.tbGreen)).BeginInit(); + ((System.ComponentModel.ISupportInitialize)(this.tbBlue)).BeginInit(); + this.SuspendLayout(); + // + // tbRed + // + this.tbRed.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(54, 64); + this.tbRed.Maximum = 512; + this.tbRed.Name = "tbRed"; + this.tbRed.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(230, 45); + this.tbRed.TabIndex = 0; + this.tbRed.Scroll += new System.EventHandler(this.tbRed_Scroll); + // + // tbGreen + // + this.tbGreen.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(54, 115); + this.tbGreen.Maximum = 512; + this.tbGreen.Name = "tbGreen"; + this.tbGreen.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(230, 45); + this.tbGreen.TabIndex = 1; + this.tbGreen.Scroll += new System.EventHandler(this.tbGreen_Scroll); + // + // tbBlue + // + this.tbBlue.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(54, 163); + this.tbBlue.Maximum = 512; + this.tbBlue.Name = "tbBlue"; + this.tbBlue.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(230, 45); + this.tbBlue.TabIndex = 2; + this.tbBlue.Scroll += new System.EventHandler(this.tbBlue_Scroll); + // + // cbPort + // + this.cbPort.FormattingEnabled = true; + this.cbPort.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(97, 12); + this.cbPort.Name = "cbPort"; + this.cbPort.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(99, 21); + this.cbPort.TabIndex = 3; + this.cbPort.SelectedIndexChanged += new System.EventHandler(this.cbPort_SelectedIndexChanged); + // + // lblRed + // + this.lblRed.Font = new System.Drawing.Font("Microsoft Sans Serif", 9.75F, System.Drawing.FontStyle.Bold, System.Drawing.GraphicsUnit.Point, ((byte)(0))); + this.lblRed.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(3, 64); + this.lblRed.Name = "lblRed"; + this.lblRed.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(48, 29); + this.lblRed.TabIndex = 4; + this.lblRed.Text = "Red"; + this.lblRed.TextAlign = System.Drawing.ContentAlignment.MiddleRight; + // + // lblBlue + // + this.lblBlue.Font = new System.Drawing.Font("Microsoft Sans Serif", 9.75F, System.Drawing.FontStyle.Bold, System.Drawing.GraphicsUnit.Point, ((byte)(0))); + this.lblBlue.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(3, 115); + this.lblBlue.Name = "lblGreen"; + this.lblBlue.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(50, 27); + this.lblBlue.TabIndex = 5; + this.lblBlue.Text = "Green"; + this.lblBlue.TextAlign = System.Drawing.ContentAlignment.MiddleRight; + // + // lblGreen + // + this.lblGreen.Font = new System.Drawing.Font("Microsoft Sans Serif", 9.75F, System.Drawing.FontStyle.Bold, System.Drawing.GraphicsUnit.Point, ((byte)(0))); + this.lblGreen.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(3, 163); + this.lblGreen.Name = "lblBlue"; + this.lblGreen.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(50, 25); + this.lblGreen.TabIndex = 6; + this.lblGreen.Text = "Blue"; + this.lblGreen.TextAlign = System.Drawing.ContentAlignment.MiddleRight; + // + // LEDMixer + // + this.AutoScaleDimensions = new System.Drawing.SizeF(6F, 13F); + this.AutoScaleMode = System.Windows.Forms.AutoScaleMode.Font; + this.ClientSize = new System.Drawing.Size(284, 207); + this.Controls.Add(this.lblGreen); + this.Controls.Add(this.lblBlue); + this.Controls.Add(this.lblRed); + this.Controls.Add(this.cbPort); + this.Controls.Add(this.tbBlue); + this.Controls.Add(this.tbGreen); + this.Controls.Add(this.tbRed); + this.FormBorderStyle = System.Windows.Forms.FormBorderStyle.FixedSingle; + this.MaximizeBox = false; + this.MinimizeBox = false; + this.Name = "LEDMixer"; + this.Text = "LED Mixer"; + this.Load += new System.EventHandler(this.LEDMixer_Load); + ((System.ComponentModel.ISupportInitialize)(this.tbRed)).EndInit(); + ((System.ComponentModel.ISupportInitialize)(this.tbGreen)).EndInit(); + ((System.ComponentModel.ISupportInitialize)(this.tbBlue)).EndInit(); + this.ResumeLayout(false); + this.PerformLayout(); + + } + + #endregion + + private System.Windows.Forms.TrackBar tbRed; + private System.Windows.Forms.TrackBar tbGreen; + private System.Windows.Forms.TrackBar tbBlue; + private System.IO.Ports.SerialPort serSerialPort; + private System.Windows.Forms.ComboBox cbPort; + private System.Windows.Forms.Label lblRed; + private System.Windows.Forms.Label lblBlue; + private System.Windows.Forms.Label lblGreen; + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/LEDMixer.cs b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/LEDMixer.cs new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dfaffed309 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/LEDMixer.cs @@ -0,0 +1,75 @@ +using System; +using System.Collections.Generic; +using System.ComponentModel; +using System.Data; +using System.Drawing; +using System.Linq; +using System.Text; +using System.Windows.Forms; + +namespace LEDMixer +{ + public partial class LEDMixer : Form + { + private const int LIGHT_MAX = 0x1F; + + public LEDMixer() + { + InitializeComponent(); + } + + private void LEDMixer_Load(object sender, EventArgs e) + { + String[] PortNames = System.IO.Ports.SerialPort.GetPortNames(); + Array.Sort<String>(PortNames, delegate(string strA, string strB) { return int.Parse(strA.Substring(3)).CompareTo(int.Parse(strB.Substring(3))); }); + cbPort.Items.Clear(); + cbPort.Items.AddRange(PortNames); + + cbPort.SelectedIndex = 0; + + tbRed.Maximum = LIGHT_MAX; + tbGreen.Maximum = LIGHT_MAX; + tbBlue.Maximum = LIGHT_MAX; + } + + private void tbRed_Scroll(object sender, EventArgs e) + { + NotifyLight(tbRed.Value, tbGreen.Value, tbBlue.Value); + } + + private void tbGreen_Scroll(object sender, EventArgs e) + { + NotifyLight(tbRed.Value, tbGreen.Value, tbBlue.Value); + } + + private void tbBlue_Scroll(object sender, EventArgs e) + { + NotifyLight(tbRed.Value, tbGreen.Value, tbBlue.Value); + } + + private void NotifyLight(int Red, int Green, int Blue) + { + byte[] buffer = new byte[3]; + buffer[0] = (byte)(0x80 | (Red & LIGHT_MAX)); + buffer[1] = (byte)(0x40 | (Green & LIGHT_MAX)); + buffer[2] = (byte)(0x20 | (Blue & LIGHT_MAX)); + + try + { + serSerialPort.PortName = cbPort.Text; + serSerialPort.Open(); + serSerialPort.Write(buffer, 0, buffer.Length); + serSerialPort.Close(); + } + catch (Exception e) + { + + } + } + + private void cbPort_SelectedIndexChanged(object sender, EventArgs e) + { + NotifyLight(tbRed.Value, tbGreen.Value, tbBlue.Value); + } + } +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/LEDMixer.csproj b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/LEDMixer.csproj new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6287ddcff1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/LEDMixer.csproj @@ -0,0 +1,95 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?> +<Project ToolsVersion="4.0" DefaultTargets="Build" xmlns="http://schemas.microsoft.com/developer/msbuild/2003"> + <PropertyGroup> + <Configuration Condition=" '$(Configuration)' == '' ">Debug</Configuration> + <Platform Condition=" '$(Platform)' == '' ">AnyCPU</Platform> + <ProductVersion>9.0.21022</ProductVersion> + <SchemaVersion>2.0</SchemaVersion> + <ProjectGuid>{A7814DA7-FA30-4A3D-878F-2E1975F9B27D}</ProjectGuid> + <OutputType>WinExe</OutputType> + <AppDesignerFolder>Properties</AppDesignerFolder> + <RootNamespace>LEDMixer</RootNamespace> + <AssemblyName>LEDMixer</AssemblyName> + <TargetFrameworkVersion>v3.5</TargetFrameworkVersion> + <FileAlignment>512</FileAlignment> + <FileUpgradeFlags> + </FileUpgradeFlags> + <OldToolsVersion>3.5</OldToolsVersion> + <UpgradeBackupLocation /> + </PropertyGroup> + <PropertyGroup Condition=" '$(Configuration)|$(Platform)' == 'Debug|AnyCPU' "> + <DebugSymbols>true</DebugSymbols> + <DebugType>full</DebugType> + <Optimize>false</Optimize> + <OutputPath>bin\Debug\</OutputPath> + <DefineConstants>DEBUG;TRACE</DefineConstants> + <ErrorReport>prompt</ErrorReport> + <WarningLevel>4</WarningLevel> + </PropertyGroup> + <PropertyGroup Condition=" '$(Configuration)|$(Platform)' == 'Release|AnyCPU' "> + <DebugType>pdbonly</DebugType> + <Optimize>true</Optimize> + <OutputPath>bin\Release\</OutputPath> + <DefineConstants>TRACE</DefineConstants> + <ErrorReport>prompt</ErrorReport> + <WarningLevel>4</WarningLevel> + </PropertyGroup> + <ItemGroup> + <Reference Include="System" /> + <Reference Include="System.Core"> + <RequiredTargetFramework>3.5</RequiredTargetFramework> + </Reference> + <Reference Include="System.Xml.Linq"> + <RequiredTargetFramework>3.5</RequiredTargetFramework> + </Reference> + <Reference Include="System.Data.DataSetExtensions"> + <RequiredTargetFramework>3.5</RequiredTargetFramework> + </Reference> + <Reference Include="System.Data" /> + <Reference Include="System.Deployment" /> + <Reference Include="System.Drawing" /> + <Reference Include="System.Windows.Forms" /> + <Reference Include="System.Xml" /> + </ItemGroup> + <ItemGroup> + <Compile Include="LEDMixer.cs"> + <SubType>Form</SubType> + </Compile> + <Compile Include="LEDMixer.Designer.cs"> + <DependentUpon>LEDMixer.cs</DependentUpon> + </Compile> + <Compile Include="Program.cs" /> + <Compile Include="Properties\AssemblyInfo.cs" /> + <EmbeddedResource Include="LEDMixer.resx"> + <DependentUpon>LEDMixer.cs</DependentUpon> + <SubType>Designer</SubType> + </EmbeddedResource> + <EmbeddedResource Include="Properties\Resources.resx"> + <Generator>ResXFileCodeGenerator</Generator> + <LastGenOutput>Resources.Designer.cs</LastGenOutput> + <SubType>Designer</SubType> + </EmbeddedResource> + <Compile Include="Properties\Resources.Designer.cs"> + <AutoGen>True</AutoGen> + <DependentUpon>Resources.resx</DependentUpon> + <DesignTime>True</DesignTime> + </Compile> + <None Include="Properties\Settings.settings"> + <Generator>SettingsSingleFileGenerator</Generator> + <LastGenOutput>Settings.Designer.cs</LastGenOutput> + </None> + <Compile Include="Properties\Settings.Designer.cs"> + <AutoGen>True</AutoGen> + <DependentUpon>Settings.settings</DependentUpon> + <DesignTimeSharedInput>True</DesignTimeSharedInput> + </Compile> + </ItemGroup> + <Import Project="$(MSBuildToolsPath)\Microsoft.CSharp.targets" /> + <!-- To modify your build process, add your task inside one of the targets below and uncomment it. + Other similar extension points exist, see Microsoft.Common.targets. + <Target Name="BeforeBuild"> + </Target> + <Target Name="AfterBuild"> + </Target> + --> +</Project>
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/LEDMixer.resx b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/LEDMixer.resx new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0601840d7b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/LEDMixer.resx @@ -0,0 +1,123 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?> +<root> + <!-- + Microsoft ResX Schema + + Version 2.0 + + The primary goals of this format is to allow a simple XML format + that is mostly human readable. The generation and parsing of the + various data types are done through the TypeConverter classes + associated with the data types. + + Example: + + ... ado.net/XML headers & schema ... + <resheader name="resmimetype">text/microsoft-resx</resheader> + <resheader name="version">2.0</resheader> + <resheader name="reader">System.Resources.ResXResourceReader, System.Windows.Forms, ...</resheader> + <resheader name="writer">System.Resources.ResXResourceWriter, System.Windows.Forms, ...</resheader> + <data name="Name1"><value>this is my long string</value><comment>this is a comment</comment></data> + <data name="Color1" type="System.Drawing.Color, System.Drawing">Blue</data> + <data name="Bitmap1" mimetype="application/x-microsoft.net.object.binary.base64"> + <value>[base64 mime encoded serialized .NET Framework object]</value> + </data> + <data name="Icon1" type="System.Drawing.Icon, System.Drawing" mimetype="application/x-microsoft.net.object.bytearray.base64"> + <value>[base64 mime encoded string representing a byte array form of the .NET Framework object]</value> + <comment>This is a comment</comment> + </data> + + There are any number of "resheader" rows that contain simple + name/value pairs. + + Each data row contains a name, and value. The row also contains a + type or mimetype. Type corresponds to a .NET class that support + text/value conversion through the TypeConverter architecture. + Classes that don't support this are serialized and stored with the + mimetype set. + + The mimetype is used for serialized objects, and tells the + ResXResourceReader how to depersist the object. This is currently not + extensible. For a given mimetype the value must be set accordingly: + + Note - application/x-microsoft.net.object.binary.base64 is the format + that the ResXResourceWriter will generate, however the reader can + read any of the formats listed below. + + mimetype: application/x-microsoft.net.object.binary.base64 + value : The object must be serialized with + : System.Runtime.Serialization.Formatters.Binary.BinaryFormatter + : and then encoded with base64 encoding. + + mimetype: application/x-microsoft.net.object.soap.base64 + value : The object must be serialized with + : System.Runtime.Serialization.Formatters.Soap.SoapFormatter + : and then encoded with base64 encoding. + + mimetype: application/x-microsoft.net.object.bytearray.base64 + value : The object must be serialized into a byte array + : using a System.ComponentModel.TypeConverter + : and then encoded with base64 encoding. + --> + <xsd:schema id="root" xmlns="" xmlns:xsd="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema" xmlns:msdata="urn:schemas-microsoft-com:xml-msdata"> + <xsd:import namespace="http://www.w3.org/XML/1998/namespace" /> + <xsd:element name="root" msdata:IsDataSet="true"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:choice maxOccurs="unbounded"> + <xsd:element name="metadata"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:sequence> + <xsd:element name="value" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" /> + </xsd:sequence> + <xsd:attribute name="name" use="required" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute name="type" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute name="mimetype" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute ref="xml:space" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + <xsd:element name="assembly"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:attribute name="alias" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + <xsd:element name="data"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:sequence> + <xsd:element name="value" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" msdata:Ordinal="1" /> + <xsd:element name="comment" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" msdata:Ordinal="2" /> + </xsd:sequence> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" use="required" msdata:Ordinal="1" /> + <xsd:attribute name="type" type="xsd:string" msdata:Ordinal="3" /> + <xsd:attribute name="mimetype" type="xsd:string" msdata:Ordinal="4" /> + <xsd:attribute ref="xml:space" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + <xsd:element name="resheader"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:sequence> + <xsd:element name="value" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" msdata:Ordinal="1" /> + </xsd:sequence> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" use="required" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + </xsd:choice> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + </xsd:schema> + <resheader name="resmimetype"> + <value>text/microsoft-resx</value> + </resheader> + <resheader name="version"> + <value>2.0</value> + </resheader> + <resheader name="reader"> + <value>System.Resources.ResXResourceReader, System.Windows.Forms, Version=2.0.0.0, Culture=neutral, PublicKeyToken=b77a5c561934e089</value> + </resheader> + <resheader name="writer"> + <value>System.Resources.ResXResourceWriter, System.Windows.Forms, Version=2.0.0.0, Culture=neutral, PublicKeyToken=b77a5c561934e089</value> + </resheader> + <metadata name="serSerialPort.TrayLocation" type="System.Drawing.Point, System.Drawing, Version=2.0.0.0, Culture=neutral, PublicKeyToken=b03f5f7f11d50a3a"> + <value>17, 17</value> + </metadata> +</root>
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/Program.cs b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/Program.cs new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8958f86d2a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/Program.cs @@ -0,0 +1,21 @@ +using System; +using System.Collections.Generic; +using System.Linq; +using System.Windows.Forms; + +namespace LEDMixer +{ + static class Program + { + /// <summary> + /// The main entry point for the application. + /// </summary> + [STAThread] + static void Main() + { + Application.EnableVisualStyles(); + Application.SetCompatibleTextRenderingDefault(false); + Application.Run(new LEDMixer()); + } + } +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/Properties/AssemblyInfo.cs b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/Properties/AssemblyInfo.cs new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c88194381e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/Properties/AssemblyInfo.cs @@ -0,0 +1,36 @@ +using System.Reflection; +using System.Runtime.CompilerServices; +using System.Runtime.InteropServices; + +// General Information about an assembly is controlled through the following +// set of attributes. Change these attribute values to modify the information +// associated with an assembly. +[assembly: AssemblyTitle("LEDMixer")] +[assembly: AssemblyDescription("")] +[assembly: AssemblyConfiguration("")] +[assembly: AssemblyCompany("Microsoft")] +[assembly: AssemblyProduct("LEDMixer")] +[assembly: AssemblyCopyright("Copyright © Microsoft 2009")] +[assembly: AssemblyTrademark("")] +[assembly: AssemblyCulture("")] + +// Setting ComVisible to false makes the types in this assembly not visible +// to COM components. If you need to access a type in this assembly from +// COM, set the ComVisible attribute to true on that type. +[assembly: ComVisible(false)] + +// The following GUID is for the ID of the typelib if this project is exposed to COM +[assembly: Guid("335c1112-9aa6-42a0-9765-5cc6deb78c88")] + +// Version information for an assembly consists of the following four values: +// +// Major Version +// Minor Version +// Build Number +// Revision +// +// You can specify all the values or you can default the Build and Revision Numbers +// by using the '*' as shown below: +// [assembly: AssemblyVersion("1.0.*")] +[assembly: AssemblyVersion("1.0.0.0")] +[assembly: AssemblyFileVersion("1.0.0.0")] diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/Properties/Resources.Designer.cs b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/Properties/Resources.Designer.cs new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..53e3f2e0b9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/Properties/Resources.Designer.cs @@ -0,0 +1,63 @@ +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +// <auto-generated> +// This code was generated by a tool. +// Runtime Version:4.0.30319.239 +// +// Changes to this file may cause incorrect behavior and will be lost if +// the code is regenerated. +// </auto-generated> +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------ + +namespace LEDMixer.Properties { + using System; + + + /// <summary> + /// A strongly-typed resource class, for looking up localized strings, etc. + /// </summary> + // This class was auto-generated by the StronglyTypedResourceBuilder + // class via a tool like ResGen or Visual Studio. + // To add or remove a member, edit your .ResX file then rerun ResGen + // with the /str option, or rebuild your VS project. + [global::System.CodeDom.Compiler.GeneratedCodeAttribute("System.Resources.Tools.StronglyTypedResourceBuilder", "4.0.0.0")] + [global::System.Diagnostics.DebuggerNonUserCodeAttribute()] + [global::System.Runtime.CompilerServices.CompilerGeneratedAttribute()] + internal class Resources { + + private static global::System.Resources.ResourceManager resourceMan; + + private static global::System.Globalization.CultureInfo resourceCulture; + + [global::System.Diagnostics.CodeAnalysis.SuppressMessageAttribute("Microsoft.Performance", "CA1811:AvoidUncalledPrivateCode")] + internal Resources() { + } + + /// <summary> + /// Returns the cached ResourceManager instance used by this class. + /// </summary> + [global::System.ComponentModel.EditorBrowsableAttribute(global::System.ComponentModel.EditorBrowsableState.Advanced)] + internal static global::System.Resources.ResourceManager ResourceManager { + get { + if (object.ReferenceEquals(resourceMan, null)) { + global::System.Resources.ResourceManager temp = new global::System.Resources.ResourceManager("LEDMixer.Properties.Resources", typeof(Resources).Assembly); + resourceMan = temp; + } + return resourceMan; + } + } + + /// <summary> + /// Overrides the current thread's CurrentUICulture property for all + /// resource lookups using this strongly typed resource class. + /// </summary> + [global::System.ComponentModel.EditorBrowsableAttribute(global::System.ComponentModel.EditorBrowsableState.Advanced)] + internal static global::System.Globalization.CultureInfo Culture { + get { + return resourceCulture; + } + set { + resourceCulture = value; + } + } + } +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/Properties/Resources.resx b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/Properties/Resources.resx new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..af7dbebbac --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/Properties/Resources.resx @@ -0,0 +1,117 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?> +<root> + <!-- + Microsoft ResX Schema + + Version 2.0 + + The primary goals of this format is to allow a simple XML format + that is mostly human readable. The generation and parsing of the + various data types are done through the TypeConverter classes + associated with the data types. + + Example: + + ... ado.net/XML headers & schema ... + <resheader name="resmimetype">text/microsoft-resx</resheader> + <resheader name="version">2.0</resheader> + <resheader name="reader">System.Resources.ResXResourceReader, System.Windows.Forms, ...</resheader> + <resheader name="writer">System.Resources.ResXResourceWriter, System.Windows.Forms, ...</resheader> + <data name="Name1"><value>this is my long string</value><comment>this is a comment</comment></data> + <data name="Color1" type="System.Drawing.Color, System.Drawing">Blue</data> + <data name="Bitmap1" mimetype="application/x-microsoft.net.object.binary.base64"> + <value>[base64 mime encoded serialized .NET Framework object]</value> + </data> + <data name="Icon1" type="System.Drawing.Icon, System.Drawing" mimetype="application/x-microsoft.net.object.bytearray.base64"> + <value>[base64 mime encoded string representing a byte array form of the .NET Framework object]</value> + <comment>This is a comment</comment> + </data> + + There are any number of "resheader" rows that contain simple + name/value pairs. + + Each data row contains a name, and value. The row also contains a + type or mimetype. Type corresponds to a .NET class that support + text/value conversion through the TypeConverter architecture. + Classes that don't support this are serialized and stored with the + mimetype set. + + The mimetype is used for serialized objects, and tells the + ResXResourceReader how to depersist the object. This is currently not + extensible. For a given mimetype the value must be set accordingly: + + Note - application/x-microsoft.net.object.binary.base64 is the format + that the ResXResourceWriter will generate, however the reader can + read any of the formats listed below. + + mimetype: application/x-microsoft.net.object.binary.base64 + value : The object must be serialized with + : System.Serialization.Formatters.Binary.BinaryFormatter + : and then encoded with base64 encoding. + + mimetype: application/x-microsoft.net.object.soap.base64 + value : The object must be serialized with + : System.Runtime.Serialization.Formatters.Soap.SoapFormatter + : and then encoded with base64 encoding. + + mimetype: application/x-microsoft.net.object.bytearray.base64 + value : The object must be serialized into a byte array + : using a System.ComponentModel.TypeConverter + : and then encoded with base64 encoding. + --> + <xsd:schema id="root" xmlns="" xmlns:xsd="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema" xmlns:msdata="urn:schemas-microsoft-com:xml-msdata"> + <xsd:element name="root" msdata:IsDataSet="true"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:choice maxOccurs="unbounded"> + <xsd:element name="metadata"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:sequence> + <xsd:element name="value" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" /> + </xsd:sequence> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute name="type" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute name="mimetype" type="xsd:string" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + <xsd:element name="assembly"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:attribute name="alias" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + <xsd:element name="data"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:sequence> + <xsd:element name="value" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" msdata:Ordinal="1" /> + <xsd:element name="comment" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" msdata:Ordinal="2" /> + </xsd:sequence> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" msdata:Ordinal="1" /> + <xsd:attribute name="type" type="xsd:string" msdata:Ordinal="3" /> + <xsd:attribute name="mimetype" type="xsd:string" msdata:Ordinal="4" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + <xsd:element name="resheader"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:sequence> + <xsd:element name="value" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" msdata:Ordinal="1" /> + </xsd:sequence> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" use="required" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + </xsd:choice> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + </xsd:schema> + <resheader name="resmimetype"> + <value>text/microsoft-resx</value> + </resheader> + <resheader name="version"> + <value>2.0</value> + </resheader> + <resheader name="reader"> + <value>System.Resources.ResXResourceReader, System.Windows.Forms, Version=2.0.0.0, Culture=neutral, PublicKeyToken=b77a5c561934e089</value> + </resheader> + <resheader name="writer"> + <value>System.Resources.ResXResourceWriter, System.Windows.Forms, Version=2.0.0.0, Culture=neutral, PublicKeyToken=b77a5c561934e089</value> + </resheader> +</root>
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/Properties/Settings.Designer.cs b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/Properties/Settings.Designer.cs new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d79f28b804 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/Properties/Settings.Designer.cs @@ -0,0 +1,26 @@ +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +// <auto-generated> +// This code was generated by a tool. +// Runtime Version:4.0.30319.239 +// +// Changes to this file may cause incorrect behavior and will be lost if +// the code is regenerated. +// </auto-generated> +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------ + +namespace LEDMixer.Properties { + + + [global::System.Runtime.CompilerServices.CompilerGeneratedAttribute()] + [global::System.CodeDom.Compiler.GeneratedCodeAttribute("Microsoft.VisualStudio.Editors.SettingsDesigner.SettingsSingleFileGenerator", "10.0.0.0")] + internal sealed partial class Settings : global::System.Configuration.ApplicationSettingsBase { + + private static Settings defaultInstance = ((Settings)(global::System.Configuration.ApplicationSettingsBase.Synchronized(new Settings()))); + + public static Settings Default { + get { + return defaultInstance; + } + } + } +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/Properties/Settings.settings b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/Properties/Settings.settings new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..39645652af --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDMixerApp/Properties/Settings.settings @@ -0,0 +1,7 @@ +<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?> +<SettingsFile xmlns="http://schemas.microsoft.com/VisualStudio/2004/01/settings" CurrentProfile="(Default)"> + <Profiles> + <Profile Name="(Default)" /> + </Profiles> + <Settings /> +</SettingsFile> diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDNotifier.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDNotifier.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f399e1164f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDNotifier.c @@ -0,0 +1,178 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the LEDNotfier project. This file contains the main tasks of + * the project and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "LEDNotifier.h" + +/** LUFA CDC Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all CDC Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .ControlInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + }, + }; + +/** Counter for the software PWM. */ +static volatile uint8_t SoftPWM_Count; + +/** Duty cycle for the first software PWM channel. */ +static volatile uint8_t SoftPWM_Channel1_Duty; + +/** Duty cycle for the second software PWM channel. */ +static volatile uint8_t SoftPWM_Channel2_Duty; + +/** Duty cycle for the third software PWM channel. */ +static volatile uint8_t SoftPWM_Channel3_Duty; + +/** Standard file stream for the CDC interface when set up, so that the virtual CDC COM port can be + * used like any regular character stream in the C APIs. + */ +static FILE USBSerialStream; + + +/** Interrupt handler for managing the software PWM channels for the LEDs */ +ISR(TIMER0_COMPA_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_ALL_LEDS; + + if (++SoftPWM_Count == 0b00011111) + SoftPWM_Count = 0; + + if (SoftPWM_Count >= SoftPWM_Channel1_Duty) + LEDMask &= ~LEDS_LED1; + + if (SoftPWM_Count >= SoftPWM_Channel2_Duty) + LEDMask &= ~LEDS_LED2; + + if (SoftPWM_Count >= SoftPWM_Channel3_Duty) + LEDMask &= ~LEDS_LED3; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); +} + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + /* Create a regular blocking character stream for the interface so that it can be used with the stdio.h functions */ + CDC_Device_CreateBlockingStream(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface, &USBSerialStream); + + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + /* Read in next LED colour command from the host */ + uint8_t ColourUpdate = fgetc(&USBSerialStream); + + /* Top 3 bits select the LED, bottom 5 control the brightness */ + uint8_t Channel = (ColourUpdate & 0b11100000); + uint8_t Duty = (ColourUpdate & 0b00011111); + + if (Channel & (1 << 5)) + SoftPWM_Channel1_Duty = Duty; + + if (Channel & (1 << 6)) + SoftPWM_Channel2_Duty = Duty; + + if (Channel & (1 << 7)) + SoftPWM_Channel3_Duty = Duty; + + fputc(&USBSerialStream, ColourUpdate); + + CDC_Device_USBTask(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Timer Initialization */ + OCR0A = 100; + TCCR0A = (1 << WGM01); + TCCR0B = (1 << CS00); + TIMSK0 = (1 << OCIE0A); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + CDC_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + CDC_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDNotifier.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDNotifier.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f094d43e51 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDNotifier.h @@ -0,0 +1,60 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for LEDNotifier.c. + */ + +#ifndef _LEDNOTIFIER_H_ +#define _LEDNOTIFIER_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <string.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDNotifier.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDNotifier.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..53728f448f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LEDNotifier.txt @@ -0,0 +1,63 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage USB LED Notifier Project + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li AT90USB646 + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Abstract Control Model (ACM)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF CDC Class Standard</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * USB LED Notifier Project. This project is designed for the Busware BUI board, however it can run easily on any + * USB AVR. It is a generic RGB LED controller (via a three channel software PWM) which listens for commands from the + * host on a CDC virtual serial port. When new commands are received, it updates the board LEDs. + * + * This can be controlled with any host application that can write to the virtual serial port, allowing it to become + * a visual notification system for any number of custom host applications, such as a new unread email notifier. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this project, which can control the project behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LUFA LED Notifier.inf b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LUFA LED Notifier.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dc3f0e74aa --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/LUFA LED Notifier.inf @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +;************************************************************ +; Windows USB CDC ACM Setup File +; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation +;************************************************************ + +[DefaultInstall] +CopyINF="LUFA LED Notifier.inf" + +[Version] +Signature="$Windows NT$" +Class=Ports +ClassGuid={4D36E978-E325-11CE-BFC1-08002BE10318} +Provider=%MFGNAME% +DriverVer=7/1/2012,10.0.0.0 + +[Manufacturer] +%MFGNAME%=DeviceList, NTx86, NTamd64, NTia64 + +[SourceDisksNames] + +[SourceDisksFiles] + +[DestinationDirs] +DefaultDestDir=12 + +[DriverInstall] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +CopyFiles=FakeModemCopyFileSection +AddReg=DriverInstall.AddReg + +[DriverInstall.Services] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +AddService=usbser, 0x00000002, LowerFilter_Service_Inst + +[DriverInstall.AddReg] +HKR,,EnumPropPages32,,"msports.dll,SerialPortPropPageProvider" + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; Vendor and Product ID Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; When developing your USB device, the VID and PID used in the PC side +; application program and the firmware on the microcontroller must match. +; Modify the below line to use your VID and PID. Use the format as shown below. +; Note: One INF file can be used for multiple devices with different VID and PIDs. +; For each supported device, append ",USB\VID_xxxx&PID_yyyy" to the end of the line. +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[DeviceList] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2044 + +[DeviceList.NTx86] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2044 + +[DeviceList.NTamd64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2044 + +[DeviceList.NTia64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2044 + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; String Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +;Modify these strings to customize your device +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[Strings] +MFGNAME="http://www.lufa-lib.org" +DESCRIPTION="LUFA CDC-ACM Virtual Serial Port"
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..01f3468381 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,51 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="LED Notifier Widget" id="lufa.projects.led_notifier.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.projects.led_notifier"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="usbkey"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="8000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="8000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.projects.led_notifier" caption="LED Notifier Widget">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ RGB LED notification widget project.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="CDC Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="LEDNotifier.txt"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="LUFA LED Notifier.inf"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="directory" value="CPUUsageApp"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="directory" value="LEDMixerApp"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="LEDNotifier.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="LEDNotifier.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..89391e8a61 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2397 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - USB LED Notifier Project" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ \ + CPUUsageApp/ \ + LEDMixerApp/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/makefile b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b426834fc5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/LEDNotifier/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = atmega32u2 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USB2AX +F_CPU = 16000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = LEDNotifier +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9c1cfe675d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define MAX_SIMULTANEOUS_NOTES 3 + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..75713f94d0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 + #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b4bcea1ee7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,314 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2048, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .Audio_ControlInterface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioControl, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 0, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_ControlSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_ControlProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_ControlInterface_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .ACSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,0,0), + .TotalLength = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t), + + .InCollection = 1, + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = AUDIO_CSCP_AudioClass, + .SubClass = AUDIO_CSCP_MIDIStreamingSubclass, + .Protocol = AUDIO_CSCP_StreamingProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .Audio_StreamInterface_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_AudioInterface_AS_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_General, + + .AudioSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,0,0), + + .TotalLength = (sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t) - + offsetof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t, Audio_StreamInterface_SPC)) + }, + + .MIDI_In_Jack_Emb = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_InputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_Embedded, + .JackID = 0x01, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_In_Jack_Ext = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_InputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_External, + .JackID = 0x02, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_Out_Jack_Emb = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_OutputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_Embedded, + .JackID = 0x03, + + .NumberOfPins = 1, + .SourceJackID = {0x02}, + .SourcePinID = {0x01}, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_Out_Jack_Ext = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_OutputTerminal, + + .JackType = MIDI_JACKTYPE_External, + .JackID = 0x04, + + .NumberOfPins = 1, + .SourceJackID = {0x01}, + .SourcePinID = {0x01}, + + .JackStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MIDI_In_Jack_Endpoint = + { + .Endpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MIDI_STREAM_OUT_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .Refresh = 0, + .SyncEndpointNumber = 0 + }, + + .MIDI_In_Jack_Endpoint_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_Jack_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSEndpoint}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSEndpoint_General, + + .TotalEmbeddedJacks = 0x01, + .AssociatedJackID = {0x01} + }, + + .MIDI_Out_Jack_Endpoint = + { + .Endpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MIDI_STREAM_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .Refresh = 0, + .SyncEndpointNumber = 0 + }, + + .MIDI_Out_Jack_Endpoint_SPC = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_MIDI_Descriptor_Jack_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSEndpoint}, + .Subtype = AUDIO_DSUBTYPE_CSEndpoint_General, + + .TotalEmbeddedJacks = 0x01, + .AssociatedJackID = {0x03} + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA MIDI Demo"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f973b4da78 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,110 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the MIDI streaming data IN endpoint, for device-to-host data transfers. */ + #define MIDI_STREAM_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 2) + + /** Endpoint address of the MIDI streaming data OUT endpoint, for host-to-device data transfers. */ + #define MIDI_STREAM_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 1) + + /** Endpoint size in bytes of the Audio isochronous streaming data IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE 64 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // MIDI Audio Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_ControlInterface; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_Interface_AC_t Audio_ControlInterface_SPC; + + // MIDI Audio Streaming Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Audio_StreamInterface; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_AudioInterface_AS_t Audio_StreamInterface_SPC; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t MIDI_In_Jack_Emb; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_InputJack_t MIDI_In_Jack_Ext; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t MIDI_Out_Jack_Emb; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_OutputJack_t MIDI_Out_Jack_Ext; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t MIDI_In_Jack_Endpoint; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_Jack_Endpoint_t MIDI_In_Jack_Endpoint_SPC; + USB_Audio_Descriptor_StreamEndpoint_Std_t MIDI_Out_Jack_Endpoint; + USB_MIDI_Descriptor_Jack_Endpoint_t MIDI_Out_Jack_Endpoint_SPC; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_AudioControl = 0, /**< Audio control interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream = 1, /**< Audio stream interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/MIDIToneGenerator.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/MIDIToneGenerator.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6d9e08a19d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/MIDIToneGenerator.c @@ -0,0 +1,252 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the MIDI demo. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "MIDIToneGenerator.h" + +/** LUFA MIDI Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all MIDI Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_MIDI_Device_t Keyboard_MIDI_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .StreamingInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_AudioStream, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = MIDI_STREAM_IN_EPADDR, + .Size = MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = MIDI_STREAM_OUT_EPADDR, + .Size = MIDI_STREAM_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + }, + }; + +/** 8-bit 256 entry Sine Wave lookup table */ +static const uint8_t SineTable[256] = +{ + 128, 131, 134, 137, 140, 143, 146, 149, 152, 156, 159, 162, 165, 168, 171, 174, + 176, 179, 182, 185, 188, 191, 193, 196, 199, 201, 204, 206, 209, 211, 213, 216, + 218, 220, 222, 224, 226, 228, 230, 232, 234, 236, 237, 239, 240, 242, 243, 245, + 246, 247, 248, 249, 250, 251, 252, 252, 253, 254, 254, 255, 255, 255, 255, 255, + 255, 255, 255, 255, 255, 255, 254, 254, 253, 252, 252, 251, 250, 249, 248, 247, + 246, 245, 243, 242, 240, 239, 237, 236, 234, 232, 230, 228, 226, 224, 222, 220, + 218, 216, 213, 211, 209, 206, 204, 201, 199, 196, 193, 191, 188, 185, 182, 179, + 176, 174, 171, 168, 165, 162, 159, 156, 152, 149, 146, 143, 140, 137, 134, 131, + 128, 124, 121, 118, 115, 112, 109, 106, 103, 99, 96, 93, 90, 87, 84, 81, + 79, 76, 73, 70, 67, 64, 62, 59, 56, 54, 51, 49, 46, 44, 42, 39, + 37, 35, 33, 31, 29, 27, 25, 23, 21, 19, 18, 16, 15, 13, 12, 10, + 9, 8, 7, 6, 5, 4, 3, 3, 2, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, + 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 2, 3, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, + 9, 10, 12, 13, 15, 16, 18, 19, 21, 23, 25, 27, 29, 31, 33, 35, + 37, 39, 42, 44, 46, 49, 51, 54, 56, 59, 62, 64, 67, 70, 73, 76, + 79, 81, 84, 87, 90, 93, 96, 99, 103, 106, 109, 112, 115, 118, 121, 124, +}; + +/** Array of structures describing each note being generated */ +static DDSNoteData NoteData[MAX_SIMULTANEOUS_NOTES]; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + MIDI_EventPacket_t ReceivedMIDIEvent; + if (MIDI_Device_ReceiveEventPacket(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface, &ReceivedMIDIEvent)) + { + if ((ReceivedMIDIEvent.Event == MIDI_EVENT(0, MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_ON)) && ((ReceivedMIDIEvent.Data1 & 0x0F) == 0)) + { + DDSNoteData* LRUNoteStruct = &NoteData[0]; + + /* Find a free entry in the note table to use for the note being turned on */ + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < MAX_SIMULTANEOUS_NOTES; i++) + { + /* Check if the note is unused */ + if (!(NoteData[i].Pitch)) + { + /* If a note is unused, it's age is essentially infinite - always prefer unused note entries */ + LRUNoteStruct = &NoteData[i]; + break; + } + else if (NoteData[i].LRUAge >= LRUNoteStruct->LRUAge) + { + /* If an older entry that the current entry has been found, prefer overwriting that one */ + LRUNoteStruct = &NoteData[i]; + } + + NoteData[i].LRUAge++; + } + + /* Update the oldest note entry with the new note data and reset its age */ + LRUNoteStruct->Pitch = ReceivedMIDIEvent.Data2; + LRUNoteStruct->TableIncrement = (uint32_t)(BASE_INCREMENT * SCALE_FACTOR) + + ((uint32_t)(BASE_INCREMENT * NOTE_OCTIVE_RATIO * SCALE_FACTOR) * + (ReceivedMIDIEvent.Data2 - BASE_PITCH_INDEX)); + LRUNoteStruct->TablePosition = 0; + LRUNoteStruct->LRUAge = 0; + + /* Turn on indicator LED to indicate note generation activity */ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDS_LED1); + } + else if ((ReceivedMIDIEvent.Event == MIDI_EVENT(0, MIDI_COMMAND_NOTE_OFF)) && ((ReceivedMIDIEvent.Data1 & 0x0F) == 0)) + { + bool FoundActiveNote = false; + + /* Find the note in the note table to turn off */ + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < MAX_SIMULTANEOUS_NOTES; i++) + { + if (NoteData[i].Pitch == ReceivedMIDIEvent.Data2) + NoteData[i].Pitch = 0; + else if (NoteData[i].Pitch) + FoundActiveNote = true; + } + + /* If all notes off, turn off the indicator LED */ + if (!(FoundActiveNote)) + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDS_NO_LEDS); + } + } + + MIDI_Device_USBTask(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** ISR to handle the reloading of the PWM timer with the next sample. */ +ISR(TIMER0_COMPA_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + uint16_t MixedSample = 0; + + /* Sum together all the active notes to form a single sample */ + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < MAX_SIMULTANEOUS_NOTES; i++) + { + /* A non-zero pitch indicates the note is active */ + if (NoteData[i].Pitch) + { + /* Use the top 8 bits of the table position as the sample table index */ + uint8_t TableIndex = (NoteData[i].TablePosition >> 24); + + /* Add the new tone sample to the accumulator and increment the table position */ + MixedSample += SineTable[TableIndex]; + NoteData[i].TablePosition += NoteData[i].TableIncrement; + } + } + + /* Output clamped mixed sample value to the PWM */ + OCR3A = (MixedSample <= 0xFF) ? MixedSample : 0xFF; +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + + /* Sample reload timer initialization */ + TIMSK0 = (1 << OCIE0A); + OCR0A = (VIRTUAL_SAMPLE_TABLE_SIZE / 8); + TCCR0A = (1 << WGM01); // CTC mode + TCCR0B = (1 << CS01); // Fcpu/8 speed + + /* Set speaker as output */ + DDRC |= (1 << 6); + + /* PWM speaker timer initialization */ + TCCR3A = ((1 << WGM31) | (1 << COM3A1) | (1 << COM3A0)); // Set on match, clear on TOP + TCCR3B = ((1 << WGM32) | (1 << CS30)); // Fast 8-Bit PWM, Fcpu speed +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + /* Set speaker as output */ + DDRC |= (1 << 6); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + + /* Disable any notes currently being played */ + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < MAX_SIMULTANEOUS_NOTES; i++) + NoteData[i].Pitch = 0; + + /* Set speaker as input to reduce current draw */ + DDRC &= ~(1 << 6); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= MIDI_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + MIDI_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Keyboard_MIDI_Interface); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/MIDIToneGenerator.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/MIDIToneGenerator.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..026a6ee38d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/MIDIToneGenerator.h @@ -0,0 +1,105 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for AudioOutput.c. + */ + +#ifndef _AUDIO_OUTPUT_H_ +#define _AUDIO_OUTPUT_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** Scale factor used to convert the floating point frequencies and ratios into a fixed point number */ + #define SCALE_FACTOR 65536 + + /** Base (lowest) allowable MIDI note frequency */ + #define BASE_FREQUENCY 27.5 + + /** Ratio between each note in an octave */ + #define NOTE_OCTIVE_RATIO 1.05946 + + /** Lowest valid MIDI pitch index */ + #define BASE_PITCH_INDEX 21 + + /** Number of samples in the virtual sample table (can be expanded to lower maximum frequency, but allow for + * more simultaneous notes due to the reduced amount of processing time needed when the samples are spaced out) + */ + #define VIRTUAL_SAMPLE_TABLE_SIZE 512 + + /** Sample table increments per period for the base MIDI note frequency */ + #define BASE_INCREMENT (((F_CPU / VIRTUAL_SAMPLE_TABLE_SIZE / 2) / BASE_FREQUENCY)) + + /* Type Defines: */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t LRUAge; + uint8_t Pitch; + uint32_t TableIncrement; + uint32_t TablePosition; + } DDSNoteData; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_UnhandledControlRequest(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/MIDIToneGenerator.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/MIDIToneGenerator.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7d0f019ee5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/MIDIToneGenerator.txt @@ -0,0 +1,73 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage MIDI Tone Generator Project + * + * \section Sec_Compat Project Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this project. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this project. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Audio Class</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Standard Audio Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Audio Class Specification \n + * USB-MIDI Audio Class Extension Specification \n + * General MIDI Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * MIDI note synthesiser project. This project implements a basic DDS frequency synthesiser, capable of producing 8-bit PWM sine + * waves of variable frequency. When attached to a USB host, this project will allow for multiple MIDI notes to be synthesised into + * audiable sound via PWM, using the notes sent to MIDI channel 1. + * + * Outgoing audio will output in 8-bit PWM onto the timer 3 output compare channel A. Decouple the audio output with a capacitor + * and attach to a speaker to hear the audio. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this project, which can control the project behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MAX_SIMULTANEOUS_NOTES</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Sets the maximum number of MIDI notes that can be generated simultaneously. More notes require more processing time, + * and thus a value that is too high will cause audiable sound distortion due to insufficient CPU time.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6795c1bb8e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="MIDI Tone Generator" id="lufa.projects.midi_tone_gen.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.projects.midi_tone_gen"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="usbkey"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="8000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="8000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.projects.midi_tone_gen" caption="MIDI Tone Generator">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ MIDI tone generator project.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="MIDI Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="MIDIToneGenerator.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="MIDIToneGenerator.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="MIDIToneGenerator.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..19bdcef4ed --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - MIDI Tone Generator Project" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/makefile b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c4132de45c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MIDIToneGenerator/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = MIDIToneGenerator +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2b417b8a90 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,58 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define MAG_T1_CLOCK (1 << 0) + #define MAG_T1_DATA (1 << 1) + #define MAG_T2_CLOCK (1 << 2) + #define MAG_T2_DATA (1 << 3) + #define MAG_T3_CLOCK (1 << 4) + #define MAG_T3_DATA (1 << 5) + #define MAG_CARDPRESENT (1 << 6) + + #define MAG_PORT PORTC + #define MAG_PIN PINC + #define MAG_DDR DDRC + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2b8d027a3d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 + #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8032bccc84 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,216 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2010 Denver Gingerich (denver [at] ossguy [dot] com) + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** HID report descriptor. This is a HID class specific descriptor, which defines the structure of the + * reports sent and received by the HID device to and from the USB host. It indicates what data is sent, + * where in the report each element is located and exactly how the data should be interpreted and used. + * + * See the HID class specification for more information on HID report descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t PROGMEM KeyboardReport[] = +{ + /* Use the HID class driver's standard Keyboard report. + * Max simultaneous keys: 6 + */ + HID_DESCRIPTOR_KEYBOARD(6) +}; + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2042, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .HID_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard, + .AlternateSetting = 0x00, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_BootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_KeyboardBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID_KeyboardHID = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(KeyboardReport) + }, + + .HID_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = KEYBOARD_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = KEYBOARD_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera and Denver Gingerich"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Magnetic Card Reader"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + case HID_DTYPE_HID: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID_KeyboardHID; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + break; + case HID_DTYPE_Report: + Address = &KeyboardReport; + Size = sizeof(KeyboardReport); + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..149fe75314 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,96 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2010 Denver Gingerich (denver [at] ossguy [dot] com) + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; /**< Configuration descriptor header structure */ + + // Keyboard HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID_Interface; /**< Keyboard interface descriptor */ + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID_KeyboardHID; /**< Keyboard HID descriptor */ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID_ReportINEndpoint; /**< Keyboard key report endpoint descriptor */ + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard = 0, /**< Keyboard interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the keyboard key press reporting endpoint. */ + #define KEYBOARD_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Size of the keyboard report endpoints, in bytes. */ + #define KEYBOARD_EPSIZE 8 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Lib/CircularBitBuffer.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Lib/CircularBitBuffer.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..802d040c5b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Lib/CircularBitBuffer.c @@ -0,0 +1,115 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2010 Denver Gingerich (denver [at] ossguy [dot] com) + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** Circular bit buffer library. This will allow for individual bits + * to be stored in packed form inside circular buffers, to reduce + * overall RAM usage. + */ + +#include "CircularBitBuffer.h" + +/** Function to initialize or reset a bit buffer, ready for data to be stored into it. */ +void BitBuffer_Init(BitBuffer_t* const Buffer) +{ + /* Reset the number of stored bits in the buffer */ + Buffer->Elements = 0; + + /* Reset the data in and out pointer structures in the buffer to the first buffer bit */ + Buffer->In.CurrentByte = Buffer->Data; + Buffer->In.ByteMask = (1 << 0); + Buffer->Out.CurrentByte = Buffer->Data; + Buffer->Out.ByteMask = (1 << 0); +} + +/** Function to store the given bit into the given bit buffer. */ +void BitBuffer_StoreNextBit(BitBuffer_t* const Buffer, + const bool Bit) +{ + /* If the bit to store is true, set the next bit in the buffer */ + if (Bit) + *Buffer->In.CurrentByte |= Buffer->In.ByteMask; + + /* Increment the number of stored bits in the buffer counter */ + Buffer->Elements++; + + /* Check if the current buffer byte is full of stored bits */ + if (Buffer->In.ByteMask == (1 << 7)) + { + /* Check if the end of the buffer has been reached, if so reset to start of buffer, otherwise advance to next bit */ + if (Buffer->In.CurrentByte != &Buffer->Data[sizeof(Buffer->Data) - 1]) + Buffer->In.CurrentByte++; + else + Buffer->In.CurrentByte = Buffer->Data; + + /* Reset the storage bit mask in the current buffer byte to the first bit */ + Buffer->In.ByteMask = (1 << 0); + } + else + { + /* Shift the current storage bit mask to the next bit in the current byte */ + Buffer->In.ByteMask <<= 1; + } +} + +/** Function to retrieve the next bit stored in the given bit buffer. */ +bool BitBuffer_GetNextBit(BitBuffer_t* const Buffer) +{ + /* Retrieve the value of the next bit stored in the buffer */ + bool Bit = ((*Buffer->Out.CurrentByte & Buffer->Out.ByteMask) != 0); + + /* Clear the buffer bit */ + *Buffer->Out.CurrentByte &= ~Buffer->Out.ByteMask; + + /* Decrement the number of stored bits in the buffer counter */ + Buffer->Elements--; + + /* Check if the current buffer byte is empty of stored bits */ + if (Buffer->Out.ByteMask == (1 << 7)) + { + /* Check if the end of the buffer has been reached, if so reset to start of buffer, otherwise advance to next bit */ + if (Buffer->Out.CurrentByte != &Buffer->Data[sizeof(Buffer->Data) - 1]) + Buffer->Out.CurrentByte++; + else + Buffer->Out.CurrentByte = Buffer->Data; + + /* Reset the retrieval bit mask in the current buffer byte to the first bit */ + Buffer->Out.ByteMask = (1 << 0); + } + else + { + /* Shift the current retrieval bit mask to the next bit in the current byte */ + Buffer->Out.ByteMask <<= 1; + } + + /* Return the retrieved bit from the buffer */ + return Bit; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Lib/CircularBitBuffer.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Lib/CircularBitBuffer.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0adbe0c89e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Lib/CircularBitBuffer.h @@ -0,0 +1,97 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2010 Denver Gingerich (denver [at] ossguy [dot] com) + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for CircularBitBuffer.c. + */ + +#ifndef _CIRCULARBITBUFFER_H_ +#define _CIRCULARBITBUFFER_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + + /* Macros: */ + #if (defined(__AVR_AT90USB1287__) || defined(__AVR_AT90USB647__) || \ + defined(__AVR_AT90USB1286__) || defined(__AVR_AT90USB646__)) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + /** Maximum number of bits which can be stored into a bit buffer. The memory usage is one eighth of this value per buffer. */ + #define MAX_BITS 8192 + #else + #define MAX_BITS 1024 + #endif + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a pointer to a bit in a bit buffer. */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t* CurrentByte; /**< Pointer to the current byte in the buffer */ + uint8_t ByteMask; /**< Mask of the current bit in the buffer */ + } BitBufferPointer_t; + + /** Type define for a circular packet bit buffer. */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Data[MAX_BITS / 8]; /**< Buffer to hold the stored bits in packed form */ + uint16_t Elements; /**< Number of stored bits in the bit buffer */ + + BitBufferPointer_t In; /**< Bit pointer to the next storage location in the buffer */ + BitBufferPointer_t Out; /**< Bit pointer to the next retrieval location in the buffer */ + } BitBuffer_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + /** Initializes or resets a given bit buffer, ready to store new bits. + * + * \param[in,out] Buffer Bit buffer to initialize + */ + void BitBuffer_Init(BitBuffer_t* const Buffer) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Stores a bit into the next location inside a given bit buffer. + * + * \param[in,out] Buffer Bit buffer to store a bit into + * \param[in] Bit Bit to store into the buffer + */ + void BitBuffer_StoreNextBit(BitBuffer_t* const Buffer, + const bool Bit) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + + /** Retrieves a bit from the next location inside a given bit buffer. + * + * \param[in,out] Buffer Bit buffer to retrieve a bit from + * + * \return Next bit from the buffer + */ + bool BitBuffer_GetNextBit(BitBuffer_t* const Buffer) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(1); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Lib/MagstripeHW.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Lib/MagstripeHW.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6d9cc8cbc4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Lib/MagstripeHW.h @@ -0,0 +1,102 @@ +/* + Copyright 2010 Denver Gingerich (denver [at] ossguy [dot] com) + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/* + NOTE: The user of this include file MUST define the following macros + prior to including the file: + + MAG_T1_CLOCK_PIN Pin connected to Track 1 clock wire (i.e.. PORTC1) + MAG_T1_DATA_PIN Pin connected to Track 1 data wire (i.e.. PORTC2) + MAG_T2_CLOCK_PIN Pin connected to Track 2 clock wire (i.e.. PORTC3) + MAG_T2_DATA_PIN Pin connected to Track 2 data wire (i.e.. PORTC0) + MAG_T3_CLOCK_PIN Pin connected to Track 3 clock wire (i.e.. PORTC5) + MAG_T3_DATA_PIN Pin connected to Track 3 data wire (i.e.. PORTC6) + MAG_CLS_PIN Pin connected to card loaded wire (i.e.. PORTC4) + MAG_PIN PIN macro for the reader's port (i.e.. PINC) + MAG_DDR DDR macro for the reader's port (i.e.. DDRC) + MAG_PORT PORT macro for the reader's port (i.e.. PORTC) + + The example macros listed above assume that the Track 2 data wire is + connected to pin 0 on port C, the Track 2 clock wire is connected to + pin 3 on port C (similarly for Tracks 1 and 3), and the card loaded + wire is connected to pin 4 on port C. + + If the mag-stripe reader you are using only reads one or two tracks, + then set the clock and data pins for the tracks it doesn't read to a + pin that is unused. For example, on the AT90USBKey, any of the pins on + port C that do not have wires attached will be unused since they are + not connected to any onboard devices (such as the joystick or + temperature sensor). + + Connecting wires to pins on different ports (i.e.. a data wire to pin 0 + on port C and a clock wire to pin 0 on port D) is currently + unsupported. All pins specified above must be on the same port. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Driver header for a TTL Magnetic Card reader device (such as the Omron V3B-4K). + */ + +#ifndef _MAGSTRIPEHW_H_ +#define _MAGSTRIPEHW_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + + #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Private Interface - For use in library only: */ + /* Macros: */ + /** Mask of the track data, clock and card detection pins. */ + #define MAG_MASK (MAG_T1_DATA | MAG_T1_CLOCK | \ + MAG_T2_DATA | MAG_T2_CLOCK | \ + MAG_T3_DATA | MAG_T3_CLOCK | \ + MAG_CARDPRESENT) + + /* Public Interface - May be used in end-application: */ + /* Inline Functions: */ + /** Initializes the magnetic stripe card reader ports and pins so that the card reader + * device can be controlled and read by the card reader driver. This must be called before + * trying to read any of the card reader's status lines. + */ + static inline void Magstripe_Init(void) + { + MAG_DDR &= ~MAG_MASK; + MAG_PORT |= MAG_MASK; + }; + + /** Returns the status of all the magnetic card reader's outputs. + * + * \return A mask indicating which card lines are high or low + */ + static inline uint8_t Magstripe_GetStatus(void) ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT; + static inline uint8_t Magstripe_GetStatus(void) + { + /* Mag-stripe IOs are active low and must be inverted when read */ + return ((uint8_t)~MAG_PIN & MAG_MASK); + } + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Magstripe.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Magstripe.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9bb6ff01a0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Magstripe.c @@ -0,0 +1,228 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2010 Denver Gingerich (denver [at] ossguy [dot] com) + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the MagStripe reader program. This file contains the main tasks of + * the project and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "Magstripe.h" + +/** Bit buffers to hold the read bits for each of the three magnetic card tracks before they are transmitted + * to the host as keyboard presses. + */ +static BitBuffer_t TrackDataBuffers[TOTAL_TRACKS]; + +/** Pointer to the current track buffer being sent to the host. */ +static BitBuffer_t* CurrentTrackBuffer = &TrackDataBuffers[TOTAL_TRACKS]; + +/** Buffer to hold the previously generated Keyboard HID report, for comparison purposes inside the HID class driver. */ +static uint8_t PrevKeyboardHIDReportBuffer[sizeof(USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t)]; + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t Keyboard_HID_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_Keyboard, + .ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Address = KEYBOARD_EPADDR, + .Size = KEYBOARD_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .PrevReportINBuffer = PrevKeyboardHIDReportBuffer, + .PrevReportINBufferSize = sizeof(PrevKeyboardHIDReportBuffer), + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + for (uint8_t Buffer = 0; Buffer < TOTAL_TRACKS; Buffer++) + BitBuffer_Init(&TrackDataBuffers[Buffer]); + + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + if (Magstripe_GetStatus() & MAG_CARDPRESENT) + ReadMagstripeData(); + + HID_Device_USBTask(&Keyboard_HID_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Magstripe_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Determines if a card has been inserted, and if so reads in each track's contents into the bit buffers + * until they are read out to the host as a series of keyboard presses. + */ +void ReadMagstripeData(void) +{ + /* Arrays to hold the buffer pointers, clock and data bit masks for the separate card tracks */ + const struct + { + uint8_t ClockMask; + uint8_t DataMask; + } TrackInfo[] = {{MAG_T1_CLOCK, MAG_T1_DATA}, + {MAG_T2_CLOCK, MAG_T2_DATA}, + {MAG_T3_CLOCK, MAG_T3_DATA}}; + + uint8_t Magstripe_Prev = 0; + uint8_t Magstripe_LCL = Magstripe_GetStatus(); + + while (Magstripe_LCL & MAG_CARDPRESENT) + { + for (uint8_t Track = 0; Track < TOTAL_TRACKS; Track++) + { + bool DataPinLevel = ((Magstripe_LCL & TrackInfo[Track].DataMask) != 0); + bool ClockPinLevel = ((Magstripe_LCL & TrackInfo[Track].ClockMask) != 0); + bool ClockLevelChanged = (((Magstripe_LCL ^ Magstripe_Prev) & TrackInfo[Track].ClockMask) != 0); + + /* Sample data on rising clock edges from the card reader */ + if (ClockPinLevel && ClockLevelChanged) + BitBuffer_StoreNextBit(&TrackDataBuffers[Track], DataPinLevel); + } + + Magstripe_Prev = Magstripe_LCL; + Magstripe_LCL = Magstripe_GetStatus(); + } + + CurrentTrackBuffer = &TrackDataBuffers[0]; +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + HID_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Keyboard_HID_Interface); + + USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + HID_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Keyboard_HID_Interface); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB device Start Of Frame event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void) +{ + HID_Device_MillisecondElapsed(&Keyboard_HID_Interface); +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the creation of HID reports to the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in,out] ReportID Report ID requested by the host if non-zero, otherwise callback should set to the generated report ID + * \param[in] ReportType Type of the report to create, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_In or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[out] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the created report should be stored + * \param[out] ReportSize Number of bytes written in the report (or zero if no report is to be sent) + * + * \return Boolean \c true to force the sending of the report, \c false to let the library determine if it needs to be sent + */ +bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize) +{ + USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t* KeyboardReport = (USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t*)ReportData; + + static bool IsKeyReleaseReport; + + /* Key reports must be interleaved with key release reports, or repeated keys will be ignored */ + IsKeyReleaseReport = !IsKeyReleaseReport; + + if ((IsKeyReleaseReport) || (CurrentTrackBuffer == &TrackDataBuffers[TOTAL_TRACKS])) + { + /* No more data to send, or key release report between key presses */ + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[0] = KEY_NONE; + } + else if (!(CurrentTrackBuffer->Elements)) + { + /* End of current track, send an enter press and change to the next track's buffer */ + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[0] = KEY_ENTER; + CurrentTrackBuffer++; + } + else + { + /* Still data in the current track; convert next bit to a 1 or 0 keypress */ + KeyboardReport->KeyCode[0] = BitBuffer_GetNextBit(CurrentTrackBuffer) ? KEY_1 : KEY_0; + } + + *ReportSize = sizeof(USB_KeyboardReport_Data_t); + return false; +} + +/** HID Class driver callback function for the processing of a received HID report from the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID interface structure for the HID interface being referenced + * \param[in] ReportID Report ID of the received report from the host + * \param[in] ReportType The type of report that the host has sent, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_Out or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[in] ReportData Pointer to the report buffer where the received report is stored + * \param[in] ReportSize Size in bytes of the report received from the host + */ +void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize) +{ + // Ignore keyboard LED reports from the host, but still need to declare the callback routine +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Magstripe.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Magstripe.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..342cd8ffe5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Magstripe.h @@ -0,0 +1,90 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2010 Denver Gingerich (denver [at] ossguy [dot] com) + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Magstripe.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MAGSTRIPE_H_ +#define _MAGSTRIPE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + #include "Lib/MagstripeHW.h" + #include "Lib/CircularBitBuffer.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Total number of tracks which can be read from the card, between 1 and 3. */ + #define TOTAL_TRACKS 3 + + /** HID keyboard keycode to indicate that no is currently pressed. */ + #define KEY_NONE 0 + + /** HID keyboard keycode to indicate that the "1" key is currently pressed. */ + #define KEY_1 30 + + /** HID keyboard keycode to indicate that the "0" key is currently pressed. */ + #define KEY_0 39 + + /** HID keyboard keycode to indicate that the enter key is currently pressed. */ + #define KEY_ENTER 40 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void ReadMagstripeData(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void); + + bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize); + void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Magstripe.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Magstripe.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a11dfaf804 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Magstripe.txt @@ -0,0 +1,163 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Denver Gingerich's USBSnoop Magnetic Card Reader Project + * + * \section Sec_Compat Project Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this project. + * + * \li AT90USB1287 + * \li AT90USB1286 + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this project. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Keyboard</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Standard, USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Firmware for a USB AVR powered USB TTL magnetic stripe reader (using a card + * reader such as the Omron V3B-4K) by Denver Gingerich. This project is designed + * to be used with the open source Stripe Snoop project at <a>http://stripesnoop.sourceforge.net/</a>. + * + * See <a>http://ossguy.com/ss_usb/</a> for the USB reader hardware project website, + * including construction and support details. + * + * To use, connect your magnetic card reader device to the USB AVR as follows (pin and port mapping may be adjusted + * from the project makefile): + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Signal:</b></th> + * <th><b>AVR Port:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Track 1 Data</td> + * <td>PORTC, Pin 1</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Track 1 Clock</td> + * <td>PORTC, Pin 2</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Track 2 Data</td> + * <td>PORTC, Pin 3</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Track 2 Clock</td> + * <td>PORTC, Pin 0</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Track 3 Data</td> + * <td>PORTC, Pin 5</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Track 3 Clock</td> + * <td>PORTC, Pin 6</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Card Detect</td> + * <td>PORTC, Pin 4</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * This project is based on the LUFA Keyboard project demonstration application, written by Denver Gingerich. + * + * This application uses a keyboard HID driver to communicate the data collected a TTL magnetic stripe reader + * to the connected computer. The raw bitstream obtained from the magnetic stripe reader is "typed" through + * the keyboard driver as 0's and 1's. After every card swipe, the project will send a return key. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this project, which can control the project behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MAX_BITS</td> + * <td>CircularBitBuffer.h</td> + * <td>Gives the maximum number of bits per track which can be buffered by the device for later transmission to a host.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MAG_T1_CLOCK</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Mask for the magnetic card reader's CLOCK line for the reader's track 1 output.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MAG_T1_DATA</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Mask for the magnetic card reader's DATA line for the reader's track 1 output.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MAG_T2_CLOCK</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Mask for the magnetic card reader's CLOCK line for the reader's track 2 output.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MAG_T2_DATA</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Mask for the magnetic card reader's DATA line for the reader's track 2 output.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MAG_T3_CLOCK</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Mask for the magnetic card reader's CLOCK line for the reader's track 3 output.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MAG_T3_DATA</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Mask for the magnetic card reader's DATA line for the reader's track 3 output.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MAG_CARDPRESENT</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Mask for the magnetic card reader's card detection output.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MAG_PIN</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>PIN register that the magnetic card reader device is attached to.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MAG_PORT</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>PORT register that the magnetic card reader device is attached to.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MAG_DDR</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>DDR register that the magnetic card reader device is attached to.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9fc5311e26 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,52 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Magnetic Strip Card Reader" id="lufa.projects.magstripe.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.projects.magstripe"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="usbkey"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="8000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="8000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.projects.magstripe" caption="Magnetic Strip Card Reader">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Magnetic strip card reader project.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="Magstripe.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Magstripe.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Magstripe.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/CircularBitBuffer.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/CircularBitBuffer.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/MagstripeHW.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..23554c194b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "Denver Gingerich's Stripe Snoop Project" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/makefile b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3fc1bf526c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = NONE +F_CPU = 16000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = Magstripe +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c Lib/CircularBitBuffer.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..75713f94d0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 + #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3213e76fe2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,234 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the + * USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This + * descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding) + * the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for + * more details on HID report descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t PROGMEM MediaControlReport[] = +{ + HID_RI_USAGE_PAGE(8, 0x0C), /* Consumer Page */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0x01), /* Consumer Controls */ + HID_RI_COLLECTION(8, 0x01), /* Application */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0xB0), /* Play */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0xB1), /* Pause */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0xB3), /* Fast Forward */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0xB4), /* Rewind */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0xB5), /* Next Track */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0xB6), /* Previous Track */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0xB7), /* Stop */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0xCD), /* Play/Pause (toggle) */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0xE2), /* Mute */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0xE9), /* Volume Up */ + HID_RI_USAGE(8, 0xEA), /* Volume Down */ + HID_RI_REPORT_SIZE(8, 0x01), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x0B), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MINIMUM(8, 0), + HID_RI_LOGICAL_MAXIMUM(8, 1), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_DATA | HID_IOF_VARIABLE | HID_IOF_RELATIVE), + HID_RI_REPORT_COUNT(8, 0x05), + HID_RI_INPUT(8, HID_IOF_CONSTANT), + HID_RI_END_COLLECTION(0), +}; + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x206A, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .HID_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_HID, + .AlternateSetting = 0x00, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_NonBootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_NonBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID_MediaControlHID = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(MediaControlReport) + }, + + .HID_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MEDIACONTROL_HID_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MEDIACONTROL_HID_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Media Controller"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + case HID_DTYPE_HID: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID_MediaControlHID; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + break; + case HID_DTYPE_Report: + Address = &MediaControlReport; + Size = sizeof(MediaControlReport); + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e0e29dc106 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Media Controller HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID_Interface; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID_MediaControlHID; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID_ReportINEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_HID = 0, /**< HID interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Media Control HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define MEDIACONTROL_HID_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Size in bytes of the Media Control HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define MEDIACONTROL_HID_EPSIZE 8 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/MediaController.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/MediaController.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5b3121a50b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/MediaController.c @@ -0,0 +1,184 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the MediaControl project. This file contains the main tasks of + * the demo and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "MediaController.h" + +/** Buffer to hold the previously generated Media Control HID report, for comparison purposes inside the HID class driver. */ +static uint8_t PrevMediaControlHIDReportBuffer[sizeof(USB_MediaReport_Data_t)]; + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t MediaControl_HID_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_HID, + .ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Address = MEDIACONTROL_HID_EPADDR, + .Size = MEDIACONTROL_HID_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .PrevReportINBuffer = PrevMediaControlHIDReportBuffer, + .PrevReportINBufferSize = sizeof(PrevMediaControlHIDReportBuffer), + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + HID_Device_USBTask(&MediaControl_HID_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware() +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Joystick_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + Buttons_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= HID_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&MediaControl_HID_Interface); + + USB_Device_EnableSOFEvents(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + HID_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&MediaControl_HID_Interface); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB device Start Of Frame event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void) +{ + HID_Device_MillisecondElapsed(&MediaControl_HID_Interface); +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the creation of HID reports to the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in,out] ReportID Report ID requested by the host if non-zero, otherwise callback should set to the generated report ID + * \param[in] ReportType Type of the report to create, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_In or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[out] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the created report should be stored + * \param[out] ReportSize Number of bytes written in the report (or zero if no report is to be sent) + * + * \return Boolean \c true to force the sending of the report, \c false to let the library determine if it needs to be sent + */ +bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize) +{ + USB_MediaReport_Data_t* MediaReport = (USB_MediaReport_Data_t*)ReportData; + + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + uint8_t ButtonStatus_LCL = Buttons_GetStatus(); + + /* Update the Media Control report with the user button presses */ + MediaReport->Mute = ((ButtonStatus_LCL & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) ? true : false); + MediaReport->PlayPause = ((JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_PRESS) ? true : false); + MediaReport->VolumeUp = ((JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) ? true : false); + MediaReport->VolumeDown = ((JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) ? true : false); + MediaReport->PreviousTrack = ((JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) ? true : false); + MediaReport->NextTrack = ((JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) ? true : false); + + *ReportSize = sizeof(USB_MediaReport_Data_t); + return false; +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the processing of HID reports from the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in] ReportID Report ID of the received report from the host + * \param[in] ReportType The type of report that the host has sent, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_Out or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[in] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the received report has been stored + * \param[in] ReportSize Size in bytes of the received HID report + */ +void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize) +{ + // Unused (but mandatory for the HID class driver) in this demo, since there are no Host->Device reports +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/MediaController.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/MediaController.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0e8ed5d6f5 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/MediaController.h @@ -0,0 +1,110 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for MediaControl.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MEDIACONTROL_H_ +#define _MEDIACONTROL_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a Media Control HID report. This report contains the bits to match the usages defined + * in the HID report of the device. When set to a true value, the relevant media controls on the host will + * be triggered. + */ + typedef struct + { + unsigned Play : 1; + unsigned Pause : 1; + unsigned FForward : 1; + unsigned Rewind : 1; + unsigned NextTrack : 1; + unsigned PreviousTrack : 1; + unsigned Stop : 1; + unsigned PlayPause : 1; + unsigned Mute : 1; + unsigned VolumeUp : 1; + unsigned VolumeDown : 1; + unsigned RESERVED : 5; + } ATTR_PACKED USB_MediaReport_Data_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_StartOfFrame(void); + + bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize); + void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/MediaController.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/MediaController.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..dece2132a1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/MediaController.txt @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Media Controller Project + * + * \section Sec_Compat Project Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this project. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification \n + * USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode \n + * Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Media Controller project. This project implements a basic Media Control device, to signal the host to play, pause, toggle playback, + * mute and/or adjust the host volume, in addition to other such media commands. This project may be extended to create a dedicated + * media playback control device, for home media centers or other equipment. By default, some of the most commonly used playback controls + * are controlled by the board joystick and LEDs, however this may be altered as desired. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this project, which can control the project behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2d476da51a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Media Controller" id="lufa.projects.media_control.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.projects.media_control"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="usbkey"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="8000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="8000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.projects.media_control" caption="Media Controller">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Magnetic strip card reader project.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="HID Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="MediaController.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="MediaController.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="MediaController.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7206cf6495 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Media Controller Project" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/makefile b/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4df317e89f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MediaController/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = MediaController +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..da8a8cc0d2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY + #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL +// #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE {Insert Value Here} +// #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/ConfigDescriptor.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/ConfigDescriptor.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d6a7b8726e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/ConfigDescriptor.c @@ -0,0 +1,185 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Configuration Descriptor processing routines, to determine the correct pipe configurations + * needed to communication with an attached USB device. Descriptors are special computer-readable structures + * which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + +/** Reads and processes an attached device's descriptors, to determine compatibility and pipe configurations. This + * routine will read in the entire configuration descriptor, and configure the hosts pipes to correctly communicate + * with compatible devices. + * + * This routine searches for a HID interface descriptor containing at least one Interrupt type IN endpoint. + * + * \return An error code from the GenericHIDHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t enum. + */ +uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void) +{ + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + void* CurrConfigLocation = ConfigDescriptorData; + uint16_t CurrConfigBytesRem; + + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* HIDInterface = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataINEndpoint = NULL; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Retrieve the entire configuration descriptor into the allocated buffer */ + switch (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &CurrConfigBytesRem, ConfigDescriptorData, sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData))) + { + case HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful: + break; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_InvalidData: + return InvalidConfigDataReturned; + case HOST_GETCONFIG_BuffOverflow: + return DescriptorTooLarge; + default: + return ControlError; + } + + while (!(DataINEndpoint) || !(DataOUTEndpoint)) + { + /* See if we've found a likely compatible interface, and if there is an endpoint within that interface */ + if (!(HIDInterface) || + USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextHIDInterfaceDataEndpoint) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Not all HID devices have an OUT endpoint - if we've reached the end of the HID descriptor + * but only found the mandatory IN endpoint, it's safe to continue with the device enumeration */ + if (DataINEndpoint) + break; + + /* Get the next HID interface from the configuration descriptor */ + if (USB_GetNextDescriptorComp(&CurrConfigBytesRem, &CurrConfigLocation, + DComp_NextHIDInterface) != DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_COMP_Found) + { + /* Descriptor not found, error out */ + return NoCompatibleInterfaceFound; + } + + /* Save the interface in case we need to refer back to it later */ + HIDInterface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Clear any found endpoints */ + DataOUTEndpoint = NULL; + + /* Skip the remainder of the loop as we have not found an endpoint yet */ + continue; + } + + /* Retrieve the endpoint address from the endpoint descriptor */ + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t* EndpointData = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrConfigLocation, USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t); + + /* If the endpoint is a IN type endpoint */ + if ((EndpointData->EndpointAddress & ENDPOINT_DIR_MASK) == ENDPOINT_DIR_IN) + DataINEndpoint = EndpointData; + else + DataOUTEndpoint = EndpointData; + } + + /* Configure the HID data IN pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(HID_DATA_IN_PIPE, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, DataINEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataINEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + Pipe_SetInterruptPeriod(DataINEndpoint->PollingIntervalMS); + + /* Check if the HID interface contained an optional OUT data endpoint */ + if (DataOUTEndpoint) + { + /* Configure the HID data OUT pipe */ + Pipe_ConfigurePipe(HID_DATA_OUT_PIPE, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointAddress, DataOUTEndpoint->EndpointSize, 1); + } + + /* Valid data found, return success */ + return SuccessfulConfigRead; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Interface descriptor of the correct HID Class value. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextHIDInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + /* Determine if the current descriptor is an interface descriptor */ + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t* Interface = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Interface_t); + + /* Check the HID descriptor class and protocol, break out if correct class/protocol interface found */ + if (Interface->Class == HID_CLASS) + { + /* Indicate that the descriptor being searched for has been found */ + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + } + + /* Current descriptor does not match what this comparator is looking for */ + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; +} + +/** Descriptor comparator function. This comparator function is can be called while processing an attached USB device's + * configuration descriptor, to search for a specific sub descriptor. It can also be used to abort the configuration + * descriptor processing if an incompatible descriptor configuration is found. + * + * This comparator searches for the next Endpoint descriptor inside the current interface descriptor, + * aborting the search if another interface descriptor is found before the required endpoint. + * + * \return A value from the DSEARCH_Return_ErrorCodes_t enum + */ +uint8_t DComp_NextHIDInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor) +{ + USB_Descriptor_Header_t* Header = DESCRIPTOR_PCAST(CurrentDescriptor, USB_Descriptor_Header_t); + + /* Determine the type of the current descriptor */ + if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Endpoint) + { + /* Indicate that the descriptor being searched for has been found */ + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Found; + } + else if (Header->Type == DTYPE_Interface) + { + /* Indicate that the search has failed prematurely and should be aborted */ + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_Fail; + } + else + { + /* Current descriptor does not match what this comparator is looking for */ + return DESCRIPTOR_SEARCH_NotFound; + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/ConfigDescriptor.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/ConfigDescriptor.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..32e86ad7eb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/ConfigDescriptor.h @@ -0,0 +1,72 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for ConfigDescriptor.c. + */ + +#ifndef _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ +#define _CONFIGDESCRIPTOR_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "MissileLauncher.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Interface Class value for the Human Interface Device class. */ + #define HID_CLASS 0x03 + + /** Pipe address for the HID data IN pipe. */ + #define HID_DATA_IN_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Pipe address for the HID data OUT pipe. */ + #define HID_DATA_OUT_PIPE (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /* Enums: */ + /** Enum for the possible return codes of the \ref ProcessConfigurationDescriptor() function. */ + enum GenericHIDHost_GetConfigDescriptorDataCodes_t + { + SuccessfulConfigRead = 0, /**< Configuration Descriptor was processed successfully */ + ControlError = 1, /**< A control request to the device failed to complete successfully */ + DescriptorTooLarge = 2, /**< The device's Configuration Descriptor is too large to process */ + InvalidConfigDataReturned = 3, /**< The device returned an invalid Configuration Descriptor */ + NoCompatibleInterfaceFound = 4, /**< A compatible interface with the required endpoints was not found */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t ProcessConfigurationDescriptor(void); + + uint8_t DComp_NextHIDInterface(void* CurrentDescriptor); + uint8_t DComp_NextHIDInterfaceDataEndpoint(void* CurrentDescriptor); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/MissileLauncher.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/MissileLauncher.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..006543d86d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/MissileLauncher.c @@ -0,0 +1,323 @@ +/* + USB Missile Launcher Demo + Copyright (C) Dave Fletcher, 2010. + fletch at fletchtronics dot net + + Based on research by Scott Weston at + http://code.google.com/p/pymissile + */ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2010 Dave Fletcher (fletch [at] fletchtronics [dot] net) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/* + * Missile Launcher host. This is a host driver for the popular USB-controller table top toy missile launchers, + * which can typically aim and fire small foam "missiles" from a spring-loaded turret. This project controls the + * launcher via a joystick and button to aim and fire missiles at targets without a PC. + */ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the MissileLauncher application. This file contains the main tasks of + * the application and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration as well + * as the sending of commands to the attached launcher toy. + */ + +#include "MissileLauncher.h" + +/** Launcher first init command report data sequence */ +static const uint8_t CMD_INITA[8] = { 85, 83, 66, 67, 0, 0, 4, 0 }; + +/** Launcher second init command report data sequence */ +static const uint8_t CMD_INITB[8] = { 85, 83, 66, 67, 0, 64, 2, 0 }; + +/** Launcher command report data sequence to stop all movement */ +static const uint8_t CMD_STOP[8] = { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 8, 8 }; + +/** Launcher command report data sequence to move left */ +static const uint8_t CMD_LEFT[8] = { 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 8, 8 }; + +/** Launcher command report data sequence to move right */ +static const uint8_t CMD_RIGHT[8] = { 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 8, 8 }; + +/** Launcher command report data sequence to move up */ +static const uint8_t CMD_UP[8] = { 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 8, 8 }; + +/** Launcher command report data sequence to move down */ +static const uint8_t CMD_DOWN[8] = { 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 8, 8 }; + +/** Launcher command report data sequence to move left and up */ +static const uint8_t CMD_LEFTUP[8] = { 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 0, 8, 8 }; + +/** Launcher command report data sequence to move right and up */ +static const uint8_t CMD_RIGHTUP[8] = { 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 8, 8 }; + +/** Launcher command report data sequence to move left and down */ +static const uint8_t CMD_LEFTDOWN[8] = { 0, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 8, 8 }; + +/** Launcher command report data sequence to move right and down */ +static const uint8_t CMD_RIGHTDOWN[8] = { 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 8, 8 }; + +/** Launcher command report data sequence to fire a missile */ +static const uint8_t CMD_FIRE[8] = { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 8, 8 }; + +/** Last command sent to the launcher, to determine what new command (if any) must be sent */ +static const uint8_t* CmdState; + +/** Buffer to hold a command to send to the launcher */ +static uint8_t CmdBuffer[LAUNCHER_CMD_BUFFER_SIZE]; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + CmdState = CMD_STOP; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + Read_Joystick_Status(); + DiscardNextReport(); + + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); + Joystick_Init(); + Buttons_Init(); +} + +/** Reads the joystick and button status, sending commands to the launcher as needed. */ +void Read_Joystick_Status(void) +{ + uint8_t JoyStatus_LCL = Joystick_GetStatus(); + uint8_t Buttons_LCL = Buttons_GetStatus(); + + if (Buttons_LCL & BUTTONS_BUTTON1) + Send_Command(CMD_FIRE); + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_UP) + Send_Command(CMD_UP); + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_DOWN) + Send_Command(CMD_DOWN); + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_LEFT) + Send_Command(CMD_LEFT); + else if (JoyStatus_LCL & JOY_RIGHT) + Send_Command(CMD_RIGHT); + else if (CmdState != CMD_STOP) + Send_Command(CMD_STOP); +} + +/** Lower level send routine, copies report into a larger buffer and sends. + * + * \param[in] Report Report data to send. + * \param[in] ReportSize Report length in bytes. + */ +void Send_Command_Report(const uint8_t* const Report, + const uint16_t ReportSize) +{ + memcpy(CmdBuffer, Report, 8); + WriteNextReport(CmdBuffer, ReportSize); +} + +/** Sends one of the \c CMD_* command constants to the attached device. + * + * \param[in] Command One of the command constants. + */ +void Send_Command(const uint8_t* const Command) +{ + if ((CmdState == CMD_STOP && Command != CMD_STOP) || + (CmdState != CMD_STOP && Command == CMD_STOP)) + { + LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_LED4); + + Send_Command_Report(CMD_INITA, 8); + Send_Command_Report(CMD_INITB, 8); + Send_Command_Report(Command, LAUNCHER_CMD_BUFFER_SIZE); + } + + CmdState = Command; +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + /* Get and process the configuration descriptor data */ + if (ProcessConfigurationDescriptor() != SuccessfulConfigRead) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + /* Set the device configuration to the first configuration (rarely do devices use multiple configurations) */ + if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Reads in and discards the next report from the attached device. */ +void DiscardNextReport(void) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Select and unfreeze HID data IN pipe */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(HID_DATA_IN_PIPE); + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Check to see if a packet has been received */ + if (!(Pipe_IsINReceived())) + { + /* Refreeze HID data IN pipe */ + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return; + } + + /* Clear the IN endpoint, ready for next data packet */ + Pipe_ClearIN(); + + /* Refreeze HID data IN pipe */ + Pipe_Freeze(); +} + +/** Writes a report to the attached device. + * + * \param[in] ReportOUTData Buffer containing the report to send to the device + * \param[in] ReportLength Length of the report to send + */ +void WriteNextReport(uint8_t* const ReportOUTData, + const uint16_t ReportLength) +{ + if (USB_HostState != HOST_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Select and unfreeze HID data OUT pipe */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(HID_DATA_OUT_PIPE); + + /* Not all HID devices have an OUT endpoint (some require OUT reports to be sent over the + * control endpoint instead) - check to see if the OUT endpoint has been initialized */ + if (Pipe_IsConfigured()) + { + Pipe_Unfreeze(); + + /* Ensure pipe is ready to be written to before continuing */ + if (!(Pipe_IsOUTReady())) + { + /* Refreeze the data OUT pipe */ + Pipe_Freeze(); + + return; + } + + /* Write out HID report data */ + Pipe_Write_Stream_LE(ReportOUTData, ReportLength, NULL); + + /* Clear the OUT endpoint, send last data packet */ + Pipe_ClearOUT(); + + /* Refreeze the data OUT pipe */ + Pipe_Freeze(); + } + else + { + /* Class specific request to send a HID report to the device */ + USB_ControlRequest = (USB_Request_Header_t) + { + .bmRequestType = (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE), + .bRequest = HID_REQ_SetReport, + .wValue = 0x02, + .wIndex = 0x01, + .wLength = ReportLength, + }; + + /* Select the control pipe for the request transfer */ + Pipe_SelectPipe(PIPE_CONTROLPIPE); + + /* Send the request to the device */ + USB_Host_SendControlRequest(ReportOUTData); + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/MissileLauncher.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/MissileLauncher.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8f06d6f8c6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/MissileLauncher.h @@ -0,0 +1,92 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for MissileLauncher.c. + */ + +#ifndef _MISSILELAUNCHER_HOST_H_ +#define _MISSILELAUNCHER_HOST_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <string.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Buttons.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + #include "ConfigDescriptor.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** Size of the Launcher report command buffer. */ + #define LAUNCHER_CMD_BUFFER_SIZE 64 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void Read_Joystick_Status(void); + void Send_Command_Report(const uint8_t* const Report, + const uint16_t ReportSize); + void Send_Command(const uint8_t* const Command); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + + void DiscardNextReport(void); + void WriteNextReport(uint8_t* const ReportOUTData, + const uint16_t ReportLength); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/MissileLauncher.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/MissileLauncher.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a0ddd15cd7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/MissileLauncher.txt @@ -0,0 +1,60 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage David Fletcher's Missile Launcher + * + * \section Sec_Compat Project Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this project. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this project. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Host</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Human Interface Device (HID)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF HID Specification, USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode, Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Missile Launcher host. This is a host driver for the popular USB-controller table top toy missile launchers, + * which can typically aim and fire small foam "missiles" from a spring-loaded turret. This project controls the + * launcher via a joystick and button to aim and fire missiles at targets without a PC. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this project, which can control the project behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1b8ac1bd56 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,49 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Missile Launcher" id="lufa.projects.missile_launcher.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.projects.missile_launcher"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="usbkey"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="8000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="8000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.projects.missile_launcher" caption="Missile Launcher">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Missile launcher project.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Host"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="MissileLauncher.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="MissileLauncher.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="ConfigDescriptor.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="MissileLauncher.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="ConfigDescriptor.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.buttons"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.joystick"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8a31d4536a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "Dave Fletcher's Missile Launcher Project" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/makefile b/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..882f338d89 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/MissileLauncher/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = MissileLauncher +SRC = $(TARGET).c ConfigDescriptor.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4ffe5d9c11 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 + #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 + #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..635e2ca7d8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,188 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2010 OBinou (obconseil [at] gmail [dot] com) + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM RelayBoard_DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_VendorSpecificClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x04B4, + .ProductID = 0xFD11, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(2,0,0), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = STRING_ID_Serial, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM RelayBoard_ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 1, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED, + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(500) + }, + + .RelayBoardInterface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_RelayBoard, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 0, + + .Class = USB_CSCP_VendorSpecificClass, + .SubClass = 0x00, + .Protocol = 0x00, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM RelayBoard_LanguageString = +{ + .Header = {.Size = USB_STRING_LEN(1), .Type = DTYPE_String}, + + .UnicodeString = {LANGUAGE_ID_ENG} +}; + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM RelayBoard_ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"SISPM"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM RelayBoard_ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"RelayBoard"); + +/** Serial number string. This is a Unicode string containing the device's unique serial number, expressed as a + * series of uppercase hexadecimal digits. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM RelayBoard_SerialString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"00001"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &RelayBoard_DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &RelayBoard_ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &RelayBoard_LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&RelayBoard_LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &RelayBoard_ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&RelayBoard_ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &RelayBoard_ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&RelayBoard_ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Serial: + Address = &RelayBoard_SerialString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&RelayBoard_SerialString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f763196a0d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,84 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2010 OBinou (obconseil [at] gmail [dot] com) + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Relay Board Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t RelayBoardInterface; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_RelayBoard = 0, /**< Relay board interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + STRING_ID_Serial = 3, /**< Serial number string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/RelayBoard.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/RelayBoard.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b69ee5710a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/RelayBoard.c @@ -0,0 +1,145 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2010 OBinou (obconseil [at] gmail [dot] com) + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the RelayBoard program. This file contains the main tasks of + * the project and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "RelayBoard.h" + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + USB_USBTask(); +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the project's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + USB_Init(); + + /* Initialize Relays */ + DDRC |= ALL_RELAYS; + PORTC &= ~ALL_RELAYS; +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + const uint8_t SerialNumber[5] = { 0, 0, 0, 0, 1 }; + uint8_t ControlData[2] = { 0, 0 }; + + switch (USB_ControlRequest.bRequest) + { + case 0x09: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_LED1); + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + Endpoint_Read_Control_Stream_LE(ControlData, sizeof(ControlData)); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + switch (USB_ControlRequest.wValue) + { + case 0x303: + if (ControlData[1]) PORTC &= ~RELAY1; else PORTC |= RELAY1; + break; + case 0x306: + if (ControlData[1]) PORTC &= ~RELAY2; else PORTC |= RELAY2; + break; + case 0x309: + if (ControlData[1]) PORTC &= ~RELAY3; else PORTC |= RELAY3; + break; + case 0x30c: + if (ControlData[1]) PORTC &= ~RELAY4; else PORTC |= RELAY4; + break; + } + } + + break; + case 0x01: + if (USB_ControlRequest.bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE)) + { + LEDs_ToggleLEDs(LEDS_LED1); + + Endpoint_ClearSETUP(); + + switch (USB_ControlRequest.wValue) + { + case 0x301: + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(SerialNumber, sizeof(SerialNumber)); + break; + case 0x303: + ControlData[1] = (PORTC & RELAY1) ? 2 : 3; + break; + case 0x306: + ControlData[1] = (PORTC & RELAY2) ? 2 : 3; + break; + case 0x309: + ControlData[1] = (PORTC & RELAY3) ? 2 : 3; + break; + case 0x30c: + ControlData[1] = (PORTC & RELAY4) ? 2 : 3; + break; + } + + if (ControlData[1]) + Endpoint_Write_Control_Stream_LE(ControlData, sizeof(ControlData)); + + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + } + + break; + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/RelayBoard.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/RelayBoard.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..31ea732982 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/RelayBoard.h @@ -0,0 +1,65 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2010 OBinou (obconseil [at] gmail [dot] com) + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for RelayBoard.c. + */ + +#ifndef _RELAYBOARD_H_ +#define _RELAYBOARD_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + #define RELAY1 (1 << 7) + #define RELAY2 (1 << 6) + #define RELAY3 (1 << 5) + #define RELAY4 (1 << 4) + #define ALL_RELAYS (RELAY1 | RELAY2 | RELAY3 | RELAY4) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/RelayBoard.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/RelayBoard.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4b190dfe32 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/RelayBoard.txt @@ -0,0 +1,106 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage OB's Quad-Relay outlet control using a Teensy2++ + * + * \section Sec_Compat Project Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this project. + * + * \li AT90USB1286 + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this project. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>None</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>None</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USB Standards</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Low Speed Mode, Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Firmware for a Teensy2++ AVR-based miniboard to control four relays, using the + * same protocol used by the commercially available Silver Shield PM power outlets + * ( http://sourceforge.net/projects/sispmctl ) sold for some time. Because this + * project mimics the original device, it can be controlled using the "sismpctl" + * package included in many Linux distributions - including router-orientated + * versions such as OpenWRT - to control the board's relays. + * + * Relays 1 to 4 are respectively wired to pins C4, C5, C6 and C7 of the Teensy++ V2, + * which are the PORTC bits 4 to 7 of the AT90USB1286. The relays MUST be wired through + * a transistor, and a diode must be added in antiparallel on the relay's coil pins to + * protect the transistor from back EMF generated from the relay when the coil is turned off. + * The transistor base pin is wired to the Teensy data port through a 10K resistor. A + * LED may be also be added as a relay status indicator on each channel. + * + * The Relay coil will be driven by the transistor, but the power will come from + * the 5V from the PC's USB port: Be careful in choosing the relay to avoid overloading + * the PC, as the maximum current used MUST remains under ~450mA @ 5V. + * + * The author's tested relays are 2 Finder 32.21.7.005.2000, coil il 125ohm, which can + * handle 5A @ 250VAC. Be careful to use proper isolation if high voltages are manipulated. + * The author used Hotglue to isolate all parts of the PCB in contact with high voltage. + * + * See <a>http://www.pjrc.com/teensy/</a> for the Teensy2++ website. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Signal:</b></td> + * <td><b>AVR Port:</b></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Relay 1</td> + * <td>PORTC, Pin 4</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Relay 2</td> + * <td>PORTC, Pin 5</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Relay 3</td> + * <td>PORTC, Pin 6</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Relay 4</td> + * <td>PORTC, Pin 7</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>Teensy2++ Yellow Led</td> + * <td>PORTD, pin 6</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this project, which can control the project behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e3a2ef4b20 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,47 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="Relay Board Controller" id="lufa.projects.relay_board.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.projects.relay_board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="usbkey"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="8000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="8000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.projects.relay_board" caption="Relay Board Controller">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ Relay Board Controller project.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Low Level APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="RelayBoard.txt"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="RelayBoard.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="RelayBoard.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..12224900eb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "OB's Dual-Relay Outlet Control Project" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/makefile b/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9553a85859 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/RelayBoard/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = RelayBoard +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6b113c8276 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 + #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..374ee0a16b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,257 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2012 Simon Foster (simon.foster [at] inbox [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + +/* On some devices, there is a factory set internal serial number which can be automatically sent to the host as + * the device's serial number when the Device Descriptor's .SerialNumStrIndex entry is set to USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL. + * This allows the host to track a device across insertions on different ports, allowing them to retain allocated + * resources like COM port numbers and drivers. On demos using this feature, give a warning on unsupported devices + * so that the user can supply their own serial number descriptor instead or remove the USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL value + * from the Device Descriptor (forcing the host to generate a serial number for each device from the VID, PID and + * port location). + */ +#if (USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL == NO_DESCRIPTOR) + #warning USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL is not available on this AVR - please manually construct a device serial descriptor. +#endif + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x204B, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .CDC_CCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Header = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .CDCSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + }, + + .CDC_Functional_ACM = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ACM, + + .Capabilities = 0x06, + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Union = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Union, + + .MasterInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .SlaveInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + }, + + .CDC_NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0xFF + }, + + .CDC_DCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .CDC_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Simon Foster"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"USB-HD44780 Adapter"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..360aa421ba --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,111 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2012 Simon Foster (simon.foster [at] inbox [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 2) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_TX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define CDC_RX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE 8 + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC data IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE 16 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // CDC Command Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_CCI_Interface; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t CDC_Functional_Header; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t CDC_Functional_ACM; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t CDC_Functional_Union; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_NotificationEndpoint; + + // CDC Data Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_DCI_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataOutEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataInEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI = 0, /**< CDC CCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI = 1, /**< CDC DCI interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/LUFA SerialToLCD.inf b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/LUFA SerialToLCD.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4799bd1a7e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/LUFA SerialToLCD.inf @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +;************************************************************ +; Windows USB CDC ACM Setup File +; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation +;************************************************************ + +[DefaultInstall] +CopyINF="LUFA VirtualSerial.inf" + +[Version] +Signature="$Windows NT$" +Class=Ports +ClassGuid={4D36E978-E325-11CE-BFC1-08002BE10318} +Provider=%MFGNAME% +DriverVer=7/1/2012,10.0.0.0 + +[Manufacturer] +%MFGNAME%=DeviceList, NTx86, NTamd64, NTia64 + +[SourceDisksNames] + +[SourceDisksFiles] + +[DestinationDirs] +DefaultDestDir=12 + +[DriverInstall] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +CopyFiles=FakeModemCopyFileSection +AddReg=DriverInstall.AddReg + +[DriverInstall.Services] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +AddService=usbser, 0x00000002, LowerFilter_Service_Inst + +[DriverInstall.AddReg] +HKR,,EnumPropPages32,,"msports.dll,SerialPortPropPageProvider" + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; Vendor and Product ID Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; When developing your USB device, the VID and PID used in the PC side +; application program and the firmware on the microcontroller must match. +; Modify the below line to use your VID and PID. Use the format as shown below. +; Note: One INF file can be used for multiple devices with different VID and PIDs. +; For each supported device, append ",USB\VID_xxxx&PID_yyyy" to the end of the line. +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[DeviceList] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204B + +[DeviceList.NTx86] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204B + +[DeviceList.NTamd64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204B + +[DeviceList.NTia64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204B + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; String Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +;Modify these strings to customize your device +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[Strings] +MFGNAME="http://www.lufa-lib.org" +DESCRIPTION="LUFA CDC-ACM Virtual Serial Port"
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/Lib/HD44780.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/Lib/HD44780.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..61a9b7ec6d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/Lib/HD44780.c @@ -0,0 +1,127 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2012 Simon Foster (simon.foster [at] inbox [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +#include "HD44780.h" + +static void HD44780_WriteNibble(const uint8_t nib) +{ + /* Read PORTD and clear the ENABLE and PD0..3 bits + then OR in the data */ + + PORTD = (PORTD & ~(ENABLE | LO4_MASK)) | (nib & LO4_MASK); + + /* Enforce address setup time (tAS) 60ns + 60 @ 16MHz = <1 + Let's us a few NOPs for good measure */ + asm volatile("nop\n\t" + "nop\n\t" + :: ); + + /* Take enable high and enforce Enable High time (tEH=450ns) + 450ns @ 16MHz = 7.2 => 7 NOPs */ + + PORTD |= ENABLE; + + asm volatile("nop\n\t" + "nop\n\t" + "nop\n\t" + "nop\n\t" + "nop\n\t" + "nop\n\t" + "nop\n\t" + "nop\n\t" + :: ); + + /* Take enable low and enforce Enable Low time (tEL=500ns) + 500ns @ 16MHz = 8.0 => 7 NOPs */ + PORTD &= ~ENABLE; + + asm volatile("nop\n\t" + "nop\n\t" + "nop\n\t" + "nop\n\t" + "nop\n\t" + "nop\n\t" + "nop\n\t" + "nop\n\t" + :: ); +} + +static void HD44780_WriteByte(const uint8_t c) +{ + HD44780_WriteNibble(HI4(c)); + HD44780_WriteNibble(LO4(c)); +} + +static void HD44780_PowerUp4Bit(void) +{ + /* Wait for more than 40 ms after VCC rises to 2.7 V */ + _delay_ms(40); + HD44780_WriteNibble(0x03); // FN_SET 8-bit + + /* Wait for more than 4.1 ms */ + _delay_ms(5); + HD44780_WriteNibble(0x03); // FN_SET 8-bit + + /* Wait for more than 100 µs */ + _delay_us(100); + HD44780_WriteNibble(0x03); // FN_SET 8-bit + + /* From now on we must allow 40us for each command */ + _delay_us(50); + HD44780_WriteNibble(0x02); // FN_SET 4-bit + + /* The LCD is now in 4-bit mode so we can continue + using the 4-bit API */ + _delay_us(50); +} + +void HD44780_Initialize(void) +{ + PORTD &= ~ALL_BITS; + DDRD |= ALL_BITS; + HD44780_PowerUp4Bit(); +} + +void HD44780_WriteCommand(const uint8_t c) +{ + PORTD &= ~RS; + HD44780_WriteByte(c); + _delay_us(50); +} + +void HD44780_WriteData(const uint8_t c) +{ + PORTD |= RS; + HD44780_WriteByte(c); + PORTD &= ~RS; + _delay_us(50); +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/Lib/HD44780.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/Lib/HD44780.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0128037851 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/Lib/HD44780.h @@ -0,0 +1,64 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2012 Simon Foster (simon.foster [at] inbox [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for HD44780.c. + */ + +#ifndef _HD44780_H_ +#define _HD44780_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <util/delay.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + + /* Macros: */ + #define RS (1 << 4) /* PD4 */ + #define ENABLE (1 << 7) /* PD7 */ + + #define HI4_MASK 0xF0 + #define LO4_MASK 0x0F /* PD0-PD3 */ + + #define ALL_BITS (RS | ENABLE | LO4_MASK) + + #define HI4(c) ((c & HI4_MASK) >> 4) + #define LO4(c) ((c & LO4_MASK) >> 0) + + #define CMD_DISPLAY_ON 0x0C + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void HD44780_Initialize(void); + void HD44780_WriteData(const uint8_t c); + void HD44780_WriteCommand(const uint8_t c); + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/SerialToLCD.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/SerialToLCD.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..85abbdb50d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/SerialToLCD.c @@ -0,0 +1,170 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2012 Simon Foster (simon.foster [at] inbox [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the SerialToLCD program. This file contains the main tasks of + * the project and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "SerialToLCD.h" + +/** Circular buffer to hold data from the host before it is sent to the LCD */ +static RingBuffer_t FromHost_Buffer; + +/** Underlying data buffer for \ref FromHost_Buffer, where the stored bytes are located. */ +static uint8_t FromHost_Buffer_Data[128]; + +/** LUFA CDC Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all CDC Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .ControlInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + RingBuffer_InitBuffer(&FromHost_Buffer, FromHost_Buffer_Data, sizeof(FromHost_Buffer_Data)); + + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + /* Only try to read in bytes from the CDC interface if the transmit buffer is not full */ + if (!(RingBuffer_IsFull(&FromHost_Buffer))) + { + int16_t ReceivedByte = CDC_Device_ReceiveByte(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + + /* Read bytes from the USB OUT endpoint into the USART transmit buffer */ + if (!(ReceivedByte < 0)) + RingBuffer_Insert(&FromHost_Buffer, ReceivedByte); + } + + while (RingBuffer_GetCount(&FromHost_Buffer) > 0) + { + static uint8_t EscapePending = 0; + int16_t HD44780Byte = RingBuffer_Remove(&FromHost_Buffer); + + if (HD44780Byte == COMMAND_ESCAPE) + { + if (EscapePending) + { + HD44780_WriteData(HD44780Byte); + EscapePending = 0; + } + else + { + /* Next received character is the command byte */ + EscapePending = 1; + } + } + else + { + if (EscapePending) + { + HD44780_WriteCommand(HD44780Byte); + EscapePending = 0; + } + else + { + HD44780_WriteData(HD44780Byte); + } + } + } + + CDC_Device_USBTask(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the application's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + USB_Init(); + + /* Power up the HD44780 Interface */ + HD44780_Initialize(); + HD44780_WriteCommand(CMD_DISPLAY_ON); + + /* Start the flush timer so that overflows occur rapidly to push received bytes to the USB interface */ + TCCR0B = (1 << CS02); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + CDC_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + CDC_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/SerialToLCD.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/SerialToLCD.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..03d28799bb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/SerialToLCD.h @@ -0,0 +1,64 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + Copyright 2012 Simon Foster (simon.foster [at] inbox [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for SerialToLCD.c. + */ + +#ifndef _SERIALTOLCD_H_ +#define _SERIALTOLCD_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + #include "Lib/HD44780.h" + + #include <LUFA/Version.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/RingBuffer.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + #define COMMAND_ESCAPE 0x1B + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/SerialToLCD.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/SerialToLCD.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a2f3396489 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/SerialToLCD.txt @@ -0,0 +1,109 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Simon Foster's USB Serial to HD44780 LCD Project + * + * \section Sec_Compat Project Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this project. + * + * \li AT90USB162 + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this project. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Abstract Control Model (ACM)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF CDC Class Standard</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Firmware for a USB Virtual Serial to HD44780 LCD controller project, by Simon Foster. This + * project connects a standard HD7780 compatible LCD controller to a PC via a virtual serial + * link, so that data supplied by the host can be written to the display. This project is + * designed to use the Minimum USB AVR board, however it can be modified to suit other hardware + * if desired. + * + * LCD Datasheet: http://www.sparkfun.com/datasheets/LCD/HD44780.pdf \n + * More Information: http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/HD44780_Character_LCD \n + * + * Below are the connections between the AVR Minimus board and LCD. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>AVR Pin:</b></td> + * <td><b>HD44780 LCD Pin:</b></td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>VCC</td> + * <td>VCC</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>GND</td> + * <td>GND</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>PD0</td> + * <td>DB4</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>PD1</td> + * <td>DB5</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>PD2</td> + * <td>DB6</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>PD3</td> + * <td>DB7</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>PD4</td> + * <td>/RS</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>GND</td> + * <td>/RW</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>PD7</td> + * <td>/E</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this project, which can control the project behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f298727949 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,51 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0">
+ <project caption="USB Serial to LCD Display" id="lufa.projects.serial_to_lcd.avr8">
+ <require idref="lufa.projects.serial_to_lcd"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/>
+ <generator value="as5_8"/>
+
+ <device-support value="at90usb1287"/>
+ <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="usbkey"/>
+
+ <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="8000000UL"/>
+ <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="8000000UL"/>
+ </project>
+
+ <module type="application" id="lufa.projects.serial_to_lcd" caption="USB Serial to LCD Display">
+ <info type="description" value="summary">
+ USB Serial to LCD Controller project.
+ </info>
+
+ <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/>
+
+ <info type="keyword" value="Technology">
+ <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/>
+ <keyword value="USB Device"/>
+ <keyword value="CDC Class"/>
+ </info>
+
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/>
+ <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/>
+
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="SerialToLCD.txt"/>
+ <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="LUFA SerialToLCD.inf"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="SerialToLCD.c"/>
+ <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="SerialToLCD.h"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/>
+
+ <build type="c-source" value="Lib/HD44780.c"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Lib/HD44780.h"/>
+
+ <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/>
+ <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/>
+
+ <require idref="lufa.common"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.platform"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/>
+ <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ringbuffer"/>
+ </module>
+</asf>
diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..64b4d5a83a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "Simon Foster's USB Serial to HD44780 LCD Project" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/makefile b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..76e7350e7b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/SerialToLCD/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb162 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = MINIMUS +F_CPU = 16000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = SerialToLCD +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c Lib/HD44780.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fcfcb2590e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,48 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define DUMMY_RTC + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f7d7e62708 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 + #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c07a588782 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,257 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + + +/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the + * USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This + * descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding) + * the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for + * more details on HID report descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t PROGMEM GenericReport[] = +{ + /* Use the HID class driver's standard Vendor HID report. + * Vendor Usage Page: 1 + * Vendor Collection Usage: 1 + * Vendor Report IN Usage: 2 + * Vendor Report OUT Usage: 3 + * Vendor Report Size: GENERIC_REPORT_SIZE + */ + HID_DESCRIPTOR_VENDOR(0x00, 0x01, 0x02, 0x03, GENERIC_REPORT_SIZE) +}; + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_NoDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2063, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .MS_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = MS_CSCP_MassStorageClass, + .SubClass = MS_CSCP_SCSITransparentSubclass, + .Protocol = MS_CSCP_BulkOnlyTransportProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MS_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .MS_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .HID_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_HID, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = HID_CSCP_HIDClass, + .SubClass = HID_CSCP_NonBootSubclass, + .Protocol = HID_CSCP_NonBootProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .HID_GenericHID = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t), .Type = HID_DTYPE_HID}, + + .HIDSpec = VERSION_BCD(1,1,1), + .CountryCode = 0x00, + .TotalReportDescriptors = 1, + .HIDReportType = HID_DTYPE_Report, + .HIDReportLength = sizeof(GenericReport) + }, + + .HID_ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = GENERIC_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = GENERIC_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Temperature Datalogger"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + case HID_DTYPE_HID: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor.HID_GenericHID; + Size = sizeof(USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t); + break; + case HID_DTYPE_Report: + Address = &GenericReport; + Size = sizeof(GenericReport); + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ffbd65d465 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,87 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "TempDataLogger.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Mass Storage device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the Mass Storage host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) + + /** Size in bytes of the Mass Storage data endpoints. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE 64 + + /** Endpoint address of the Generic HID reporting IN endpoint. */ + #define GENERIC_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Size in bytes of the Generic HID reporting endpoint. */ + #define GENERIC_EPSIZE 16 + + /** Size in bytes of the Generic HID reports (including report ID byte). */ + #define GENERIC_REPORT_SIZE sizeof(Device_Report_t) + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // Mass Storage Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t MS_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t MS_DataInEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t MS_DataOutEndpoint; + + // Settings Management Generic HID Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t HID_Interface; + USB_HID_Descriptor_HID_t HID_GenericHID; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HID_ReportINEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage = 0, /**< Mass storage interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_HID = 1, /**< HID interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/DataflashManager.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/DataflashManager.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b1111ce39b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/DataflashManager.c @@ -0,0 +1,534 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Functions to manage the physical Dataflash media, including reading and writing of + * blocks of data. These functions are called by the SCSI layer when data must be stored + * or retrieved to/from the physical storage media. If a different media is used (such + * as a SD card or EEPROM), functions similar to these will need to be generated. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_DATAFLASHMANAGER_C +#include "DataflashManager.h" + +/** Writes blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) to the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), from + * the pre-selected data OUT endpoint. This routine reads in OS sized blocks from the endpoint and writes + * them to the Dataflash in Dataflash page sized blocks. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Mass Storage Class configuration and state + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the write sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to write + */ +void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + bool UsingSecondBuffer = false; + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, CurrDFPageByte); + + /* Wait until endpoint is ready before continuing */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Write an endpoint packet sized data block to the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if the endpoint is currently empty */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + /* Clear the current endpoint bank */ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + /* Wait until the host has sent another packet */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + } + + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Once all the Dataflash ICs have had their first buffers filled, switch buffers to maintain throughput */ + if (Dataflash_GetSelectedChip() == DATAFLASH_CHIP_MASK(DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS)) + UsingSecondBuffer = !(UsingSecondBuffer); + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* If less than one Dataflash page remaining, copy over the existing page to preserve trailing data */ + if ((TotalBlocks * (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) < (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF2 : DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + } +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2WRITE : DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, 0); + } + + /* Write one 16-byte chunk of data to the Dataflash */ + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + + /* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ + if (MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset) + return; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0x00); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + + /* If the endpoint is empty, clear it ready for the next packet from the host */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Reads blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) from the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), into + * the pre-selected data IN endpoint. This routine reads in Dataflash page sized blocks from the Dataflash + * and writes them in OS sized blocks to the endpoint. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Mass Storage Class configuration and state + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the read sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to read + */ +void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, CurrDFPageByte); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + + /* Wait until endpoint is ready before continuing */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Read an endpoint packet sized data block from the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if the endpoint is currently full */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + /* Clear the endpoint bank to send its contents to the host */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Wait until the endpoint is ready for more data */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + } + + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + } + + /* Read one 16-byte chunk of data from the Dataflash */ + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + + /* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ + if (MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset) + return; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* If the endpoint is full, send its contents to the host */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Writes blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) to the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), from + * the given RAM buffer. This routine reads in OS sized blocks from the buffer and writes them to the + * Dataflash in Dataflash page sized blocks. This can be linked to FAT libraries to write files to the + * Dataflash. + * + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the write sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to write + * \param[in] BufferPtr Pointer to the data source RAM buffer + */ +void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + const uint8_t* BufferPtr) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + bool UsingSecondBuffer = false; + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, CurrDFPageByte); + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Write an endpoint packet sized data block to the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Once all the Dataflash ICs have had their first buffers filled, switch buffers to maintain throughput */ + if (Dataflash_GetSelectedChip() == DATAFLASH_CHIP_MASK(DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS)) + UsingSecondBuffer = !(UsingSecondBuffer); + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* If less than one Dataflash page remaining, copy over the existing page to preserve trailing data */ + if ((TotalBlocks * (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) < (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF2 : DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + } +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2WRITE : DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, 0); + } + + /* Write one 16-byte chunk of data to the Dataflash */ + for (uint8_t ByteNum = 0; ByteNum < 16; ByteNum++) + Dataflash_SendByte(*(BufferPtr++)); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0x00); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Reads blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) from the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), into + * the preallocated RAM buffer. This routine reads in Dataflash page sized blocks from the Dataflash + * and writes them in OS sized blocks to the given buffer. This can be linked to FAT libraries to read + * the files stored on the Dataflash. + * + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the read sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to read + * \param[out] BufferPtr Pointer to the data destination RAM buffer + */ +void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, CurrDFPageByte); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Read an endpoint packet sized data block from the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + } + + /* Read one 16-byte chunk of data from the Dataflash */ + for (uint8_t ByteNum = 0; ByteNum < 16; ByteNum++) + *(BufferPtr++) = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Disables the Dataflash memory write protection bits on the board Dataflash ICs, if enabled. */ +void DataflashManager_ResetDataflashProtections(void) +{ + /* Select first Dataflash chip, send the read status register command */ + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + + /* Check if sector protection is enabled */ + if (Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_SECTORPROTECTION_ON) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + + /* Send the commands to disable sector protection */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[0]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[1]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[2]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[3]); + } + + /* Select second Dataflash chip (if present on selected board), send read status register command */ + #if (DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS == 2) + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP2); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + + /* Check if sector protection is enabled */ + if (Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_SECTORPROTECTION_ON) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + + /* Send the commands to disable sector protection */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[0]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[1]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[2]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[3]); + } + #endif + + /* Deselect current Dataflash chip */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Performs a simple test on the attached Dataflash IC(s) to ensure that they are working. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if all media chips are working, \c false otherwise + */ +bool DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation(void) +{ + uint8_t ReturnByte; + + /* Test first Dataflash IC is present and responding to commands */ + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_READMANUFACTURERDEVICEINFO); + ReturnByte = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + /* If returned data is invalid, fail the command */ + if (ReturnByte != DF_MANUFACTURER_ATMEL) + return false; + + #if (DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS == 2) + /* Test second Dataflash IC is present and responding to commands */ + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP2); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_READMANUFACTURERDEVICEINFO); + ReturnByte = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + /* If returned data is invalid, fail the command */ + if (ReturnByte != DF_MANUFACTURER_ATMEL) + return false; + #endif + + return true; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/DataflashManager.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/DataflashManager.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f0feeb67bc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/DataflashManager.h @@ -0,0 +1,86 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for DataflashManager.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DATAFLASH_MANAGER_H_ +#define _DATAFLASH_MANAGER_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + + #include "../TempDataLogger.h" + #include "../Descriptors.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h> + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE % 16) + #error Dataflash page size must be a multiple of 16 bytes. + #endif + + /* Defines: */ + /** Total number of bytes of the storage medium, comprised of one or more Dataflash ICs. */ + #define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES ((uint32_t)DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) + + /** Block size of the device. This is kept at 512 to remain compatible with the OS despite the underlying + * storage media (Dataflash) using a different native block size. Do not change this value. + */ + #define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE 512 + + /** Total number of blocks of the virtual memory for reporting to the host as the device's total capacity. Do not + * change this value; change VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES instead to alter the media size. + */ + #define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCKS (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES / VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks); + void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks); + void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + const uint8_t* BufferPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + void DataflashManager_ResetDataflashProtections(void); + bool DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/00readme.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/00readme.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..80d8843d13 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/00readme.txt @@ -0,0 +1,135 @@ +FatFs Module Source Files R0.09a (C)ChaN, 2012 + + +FILES + + ffconf.h Configuration file for FatFs module. + ff.h Common include file for FatFs and application module. + ff.c FatFs module. + diskio.h Common include file for FatFs and disk I/O module. + diskio.c An example of glue function to attach existing disk I/O module to FatFs. + integer.h Integer type definitions for FatFs. + option Optional external functions. + + Low level disk I/O module is not included in this archive because the FatFs + module is only a generic file system layer and not depend on any specific + storage device. You have to provide a low level disk I/O module that written + to control your storage device. + + + +AGREEMENTS + + FatFs module is an open source software to implement FAT file system to + small embedded systems. This is a free software and is opened for education, + research and commercial developments under license policy of following trems. + + Copyright (C) 2012, ChaN, all right reserved. + + * The FatFs module is a free software and there is NO WARRANTY. + * No restriction on use. You can use, modify and redistribute it for + personal, non-profit or commercial product UNDER YOUR RESPONSIBILITY. + * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice. + + + +REVISION HISTORY + + Feb 26, 2006 R0.00 Prototype + + Apr 29, 2006 R0.01 First release. + + Jun 01, 2006 R0.02 Added FAT12. + Removed unbuffered mode. + Fixed a problem on small (<32M) patition. + + Jun 10, 2006 R0.02a Added a configuration option _FS_MINIMUM. + + Sep 22, 2006 R0.03 Added f_rename. + Changed option _FS_MINIMUM to _FS_MINIMIZE. + + Dec 11, 2006 R0.03a Improved cluster scan algolithm to write files fast. + Fixed f_mkdir creates incorrect directory on FAT32. + + Feb 04, 2007 R0.04 Supported multiple drive system. (FatFs) + Changed some APIs for multiple drive system. + Added f_mkfs. (FatFs) + Added _USE_FAT32 option. (Tiny-FatFs) + + Apr 01, 2007 R0.04a Supported multiple partitions on a plysical drive. (FatFs) + Fixed an endian sensitive code in f_mkfs. (FatFs) + Added a capability of extending the file size to f_lseek. + Added minimization level 3. + Fixed a problem that can collapse a sector when recreate an + existing file in any sub-directory at non FAT32 cfg. (Tiny-FatFs) + + May 05, 2007 R0.04b Added _USE_NTFLAG option. + Added FSInfo support. + Fixed some problems corresponds to FAT32. (Tiny-FatFs) + Fixed DBCS name can result FR_INVALID_NAME. + Fixed short seek (0 < ofs <= csize) collapses the file object. + + Aug 25, 2007 R0.05 Changed arguments of f_read, f_write. + Changed arguments of f_mkfs. (FatFs) + Fixed f_mkfs on FAT32 creates incorrect FSInfo. (FatFs) + Fixed f_mkdir on FAT32 creates incorrect directory. (FatFs) + + Feb 03, 2008 R0.05a Added f_truncate(). + Added f_utime(). + Fixed off by one error at FAT sub-type determination. + Fixed btr in f_read() can be mistruncated. + Fixed cached sector is not flushed when create and close without write. + + Apr 01, 2008 R0.06 Added f_forward(). (Tiny-FatFs) + Added string functions: fputc(), fputs(), fprintf() and fgets(). + Improved performance of f_lseek() on move to the same or following cluster. + + Apr 01, 2009, R0.07 Merged Tiny-FatFs as a buffer configuration option. + Added long file name support. + Added multiple code page support. + Added re-entrancy for multitask operation. + Added auto cluster size selection to f_mkfs(). + Added rewind option to f_readdir(). + Changed result code of critical errors. + Renamed string functions to avoid name collision. + + Apr 14, 2009, R0.07a Separated out OS dependent code on reentrant cfg. + Added multiple sector size support. + + Jun 21, 2009, R0.07c Fixed f_unlink() may return FR_OK on error. + Fixed wrong cache control in f_lseek(). + Added relative path feature. + Added f_chdir(). + Added f_chdrive(). + Added proper case conversion for extended characters. + + Nov 03, 2009 R0.07e Separated out configuration options from ff.h to ffconf.h. + Added a configuration option, _LFN_UNICODE. + Fixed f_unlink() fails to remove a sub-dir on _FS_RPATH. + Fixed name matching error on the 13 char boundary. + Changed f_readdir() to return the SFN with always upper case on non-LFN cfg. + + May 15, 2010, R0.08 Added a memory configuration option. (_USE_LFN) + Added file lock feature. (_FS_SHARE) + Added fast seek feature. (_USE_FASTSEEK) + Changed some types on the API, XCHAR->TCHAR. + Changed fname member in the FILINFO structure on Unicode cfg. + String functions support UTF-8 encoding files on Unicode cfg. + + Aug 16,'10 R0.08a Added f_getcwd(). (_FS_RPATH = 2) + Added sector erase feature. (_USE_ERASE) + Moved file lock semaphore table from fs object to the bss. + Fixed a wrong directory entry is created on non-LFN cfg when the given name contains ';'. + Fixed f_mkfs() creates wrong FAT32 volume. + + Jan 15,'11 R0.08b Fast seek feature is also applied to f_read() and f_write(). + f_lseek() reports required table size on creating CLMP. + Extended format syntax of f_printf function. + Ignores duplicated directory separators in given path names. + + Sep 06,'11 R0.09 f_mkfs() supports multiple partition to finish the multiple partition feature. + Added f_fdisk(). (_MULTI_PARTITION = 2) + + Aug 27,'12 R0.09a Fixed assertion failure due to OS/2 EA on FAT12/16. + Changed API rejects null object pointer to avoid crash. + Changed option name _FS_SHARE to _FS_LOCK. diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/diskio.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/diskio.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8cc8cd4049 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/diskio.c @@ -0,0 +1,98 @@ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Low level disk I/O module skeleton for FatFs (C)ChaN, 2007 */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* This is a stub disk I/O module that acts as front end of the existing */ +/* disk I/O modules and attach it to FatFs module with common interface. */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#include "diskio.h" + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Initialize a Drive */ + +DSTATUS disk_initialize ( + BYTE drv /* Physical drive number (0..) */ +) +{ + return FR_OK; +} + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Return Disk Status */ + +DSTATUS disk_status ( + BYTE drv /* Physical drive number (0..) */ +) +{ + return FR_OK; +} + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Read Sector(s) */ + +DRESULT disk_read ( + BYTE drv, /* Physical drive number (0..) */ + BYTE *buff, /* Data buffer to store read data */ + DWORD sector, /* Sector address (LBA) */ + BYTE count /* Number of sectors to read (1..128) */ +) +{ + DataflashManager_ReadBlocks_RAM(sector, count, buff); + return RES_OK; +} + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Write Sector(s) */ + +#if _READONLY == 0 +DRESULT disk_write ( + BYTE drv, /* Physical drive number (0..) */ + const BYTE *buff, /* Data to be written */ + DWORD sector, /* Sector address (LBA) */ + BYTE count /* Number of sectors to write (1..128) */ +) +{ + DataflashManager_WriteBlocks_RAM(sector, count, buff); + return RES_OK; +} +#endif /* _READONLY */ + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Miscellaneous Functions */ + +DRESULT disk_ioctl ( + BYTE drv, /* Physical drive number (0..) */ + BYTE ctrl, /* Control code */ + void *buff /* Buffer to send/receive control data */ +) +{ + if (ctrl == CTRL_SYNC) + return RES_OK; + else + return RES_PARERR; +} + + +DWORD get_fattime (void) +{ + TimeDate_t CurrTimeDate; + + RTC_GetTimeDate(&CurrTimeDate); + + + return ((DWORD)(20 + CurrTimeDate.Year) << 25) | + ((DWORD)CurrTimeDate.Month << 21) | + ((DWORD)CurrTimeDate.Day << 16) | + ((DWORD)CurrTimeDate.Hour << 11) | + ((DWORD)CurrTimeDate.Minute << 5) | + (((DWORD)CurrTimeDate.Second >> 1) << 0); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/diskio.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/diskio.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d3c3149a59 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/diskio.h @@ -0,0 +1,55 @@ +/*----------------------------------------------------------------------- +/ Low level disk interface module include file +/-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#ifndef _DISKIO_DEFINED +#define _DISKIO_DEFINED + +#ifdef __cplusplus +extern "C" { +#endif + +#include "integer.h" + +#include "../DataflashManager.h" + + +/* Status of Disk Functions */ +typedef BYTE DSTATUS; + +/* Results of Disk Functions */ +typedef enum { + RES_OK = 0, /* 0: Successful */ + RES_ERROR, /* 1: R/W Error */ + RES_WRPRT, /* 2: Write Protected */ + RES_NOTRDY, /* 3: Not Ready */ + RES_PARERR /* 4: Invalid Parameter */ +} DRESULT; + + +/*---------------------------------------*/ +/* Prototypes for disk control functions */ + +DSTATUS disk_initialize (BYTE); +DSTATUS disk_status (BYTE); +DRESULT disk_read (BYTE, BYTE*, DWORD, BYTE); +#if _READONLY == 0 +DRESULT disk_write (BYTE, const BYTE*, DWORD, BYTE); +#endif +DRESULT disk_ioctl (BYTE, BYTE, void*); + + +/* Disk Status Bits (DSTATUS) */ + +#define STA_NOINIT 0x01 /* Drive not initialized */ +#define STA_NODISK 0x02 /* No medium in the drive */ +#define STA_PROTECT 0x04 /* Write protected */ + +/* Generic command */ +#define CTRL_SYNC 0 /* Mandatory for write functions */ + +#ifdef __cplusplus +} +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/ff.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/ff.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..059b5885ae --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/ff.c @@ -0,0 +1,4139 @@ +/*----------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ FatFs - FAT file system module R0.09a (C)ChaN, 2012 +/-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ FatFs module is a generic FAT file system module for small embedded systems. +/ This is a free software that opened for education, research and commercial +/ developments under license policy of following terms. +/ +/ Copyright (C) 2012, ChaN, all right reserved. +/ +/ * The FatFs module is a free software and there is NO WARRANTY. +/ * No restriction on use. You can use, modify and redistribute it for +/ personal, non-profit or commercial products UNDER YOUR RESPONSIBILITY. +/ * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice. +/ +/-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ Feb 26,'06 R0.00 Prototype. +/ +/ Apr 29,'06 R0.01 First stable version. +/ +/ Jun 01,'06 R0.02 Added FAT12 support. +/ Removed unbuffered mode. +/ Fixed a problem on small (<32M) partition. +/ Jun 10,'06 R0.02a Added a configuration option (_FS_MINIMUM). +/ +/ Sep 22,'06 R0.03 Added f_rename(). +/ Changed option _FS_MINIMUM to _FS_MINIMIZE. +/ Dec 11,'06 R0.03a Improved cluster scan algorithm to write files fast. +/ Fixed f_mkdir() creates incorrect directory on FAT32. +/ +/ Feb 04,'07 R0.04 Supported multiple drive system. +/ Changed some interfaces for multiple drive system. +/ Changed f_mountdrv() to f_mount(). +/ Added f_mkfs(). +/ Apr 01,'07 R0.04a Supported multiple partitions on a physical drive. +/ Added a capability of extending file size to f_lseek(). +/ Added minimization level 3. +/ Fixed an endian sensitive code in f_mkfs(). +/ May 05,'07 R0.04b Added a configuration option _USE_NTFLAG. +/ Added FSInfo support. +/ Fixed DBCS name can result FR_INVALID_NAME. +/ Fixed short seek (<= csize) collapses the file object. +/ +/ Aug 25,'07 R0.05 Changed arguments of f_read(), f_write() and f_mkfs(). +/ Fixed f_mkfs() on FAT32 creates incorrect FSInfo. +/ Fixed f_mkdir() on FAT32 creates incorrect directory. +/ Feb 03,'08 R0.05a Added f_truncate() and f_utime(). +/ Fixed off by one error at FAT sub-type determination. +/ Fixed btr in f_read() can be mistruncated. +/ Fixed cached sector is not flushed when create and close without write. +/ +/ Apr 01,'08 R0.06 Added fputc(), fputs(), fprintf() and fgets(). +/ Improved performance of f_lseek() on moving to the same or following cluster. +/ +/ Apr 01,'09 R0.07 Merged Tiny-FatFs as a configuration option. (_FS_TINY) +/ Added long file name feature. +/ Added multiple code page feature. +/ Added re-entrancy for multitask operation. +/ Added auto cluster size selection to f_mkfs(). +/ Added rewind option to f_readdir(). +/ Changed result code of critical errors. +/ Renamed string functions to avoid name collision. +/ Apr 14,'09 R0.07a Separated out OS dependent code on reentrant cfg. +/ Added multiple sector size feature. +/ Jun 21,'09 R0.07c Fixed f_unlink() can return FR_OK on error. +/ Fixed wrong cache control in f_lseek(). +/ Added relative path feature. +/ Added f_chdir() and f_chdrive(). +/ Added proper case conversion to extended char. +/ Nov 03,'09 R0.07e Separated out configuration options from ff.h to ffconf.h. +/ Fixed f_unlink() fails to remove a sub-dir on _FS_RPATH. +/ Fixed name matching error on the 13 char boundary. +/ Added a configuration option, _LFN_UNICODE. +/ Changed f_readdir() to return the SFN with always upper case on non-LFN cfg. +/ +/ May 15,'10 R0.08 Added a memory configuration option. (_USE_LFN = 3) +/ Added file lock feature. (_FS_SHARE) +/ Added fast seek feature. (_USE_FASTSEEK) +/ Changed some types on the API, XCHAR->TCHAR. +/ Changed fname member in the FILINFO structure on Unicode cfg. +/ String functions support UTF-8 encoding files on Unicode cfg. +/ Aug 16,'10 R0.08a Added f_getcwd(). (_FS_RPATH = 2) +/ Added sector erase feature. (_USE_ERASE) +/ Moved file lock semaphore table from fs object to the bss. +/ Fixed a wrong directory entry is created on non-LFN cfg when the given name contains ';'. +/ Fixed f_mkfs() creates wrong FAT32 volume. +/ Jan 15,'11 R0.08b Fast seek feature is also applied to f_read() and f_write(). +/ f_lseek() reports required table size on creating CLMP. +/ Extended format syntax of f_printf function. +/ Ignores duplicated directory separators in given path name. +/ +/ Sep 06,'11 R0.09 f_mkfs() supports multiple partition to finish the multiple partition feature. +/ Added f_fdisk(). (_MULTI_PARTITION = 2) +/ Aug 27,'12 R0.09a Fixed assertion failure due to OS/2 EA on FAT12/16 volume. +/ Changed f_open() and f_opendir reject null object pointer to avoid crash. +/ Changed option name _FS_SHARE to _FS_LOCK. +/---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#include "ff.h" /* FatFs configurations and declarations */ +#include "diskio.h" /* Declarations of low level disk I/O functions */ + + +/*-------------------------------------------------------------------------- + + Module Private Definitions + +---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#if _FATFS != 4004 /* Revision ID */ +#error Wrong include file (ff.h). +#endif + + +/* Definitions on sector size */ +#if _MAX_SS != 512 && _MAX_SS != 1024 && _MAX_SS != 2048 && _MAX_SS != 4096 +#error Wrong sector size. +#endif +#if _MAX_SS != 512 +#define SS(fs) ((fs)->ssize) /* Variable sector size */ +#else +#define SS(fs) 512U /* Fixed sector size */ +#endif + + +/* Reentrancy related */ +#if _FS_REENTRANT +#if _USE_LFN == 1 +#error Static LFN work area must not be used in re-entrant configuration. +#endif +#define ENTER_FF(fs) { if (!lock_fs(fs)) return FR_TIMEOUT; } +#define LEAVE_FF(fs, res) { unlock_fs(fs, res); return res; } +#else +#define ENTER_FF(fs) +#define LEAVE_FF(fs, res) return res +#endif + +#define ABORT(fs, res) { fp->flag |= FA__ERROR; LEAVE_FF(fs, res); } + + +/* File access control feature */ +#if _FS_LOCK +#if _FS_READONLY +#error _FS_LOCK must be 0 on read-only cfg. +#endif +typedef struct { + FATFS *fs; /* File ID 1, volume (NULL:blank entry) */ + DWORD clu; /* File ID 2, directory */ + WORD idx; /* File ID 3, directory index */ + WORD ctr; /* File open counter, 0:none, 0x01..0xFF:read open count, 0x100:write mode */ +} FILESEM; +#endif + + + +/* DBCS code ranges and SBCS extend char conversion table */ + +#if _CODE_PAGE == 932 /* Japanese Shift-JIS */ +#define _DF1S 0x81 /* DBC 1st byte range 1 start */ +#define _DF1E 0x9F /* DBC 1st byte range 1 end */ +#define _DF2S 0xE0 /* DBC 1st byte range 2 start */ +#define _DF2E 0xFC /* DBC 1st byte range 2 end */ +#define _DS1S 0x40 /* DBC 2nd byte range 1 start */ +#define _DS1E 0x7E /* DBC 2nd byte range 1 end */ +#define _DS2S 0x80 /* DBC 2nd byte range 2 start */ +#define _DS2E 0xFC /* DBC 2nd byte range 2 end */ + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 936 /* Simplified Chinese GBK */ +#define _DF1S 0x81 +#define _DF1E 0xFE +#define _DS1S 0x40 +#define _DS1E 0x7E +#define _DS2S 0x80 +#define _DS2E 0xFE + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 949 /* Korean */ +#define _DF1S 0x81 +#define _DF1E 0xFE +#define _DS1S 0x41 +#define _DS1E 0x5A +#define _DS2S 0x61 +#define _DS2E 0x7A +#define _DS3S 0x81 +#define _DS3E 0xFE + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 950 /* Traditional Chinese Big5 */ +#define _DF1S 0x81 +#define _DF1E 0xFE +#define _DS1S 0x40 +#define _DS1E 0x7E +#define _DS2S 0xA1 +#define _DS2E 0xFE + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 437 /* U.S. (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x9A,0x90,0x41,0x8E,0x41,0x8F,0x80,0x45,0x45,0x45,0x49,0x49,0x49,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0x4F,0x99,0x4F,0x55,0x55,0x59,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0x41,0x49,0x4F,0x55,0xA5,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0x21,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE4,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE8,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 720 /* Arabic (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x45,0x41,0x84,0x41,0x86,0x43,0x45,0x45,0x45,0x49,0x49,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x49,0x49,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0xA1,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE4,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE8,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 737 /* Greek (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87, \ + 0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0xAA,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0x97,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xE4,0xED,0xEE,0xE7,0xE8,0xF1,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 775 /* Baltic (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x9A,0x91,0xA0,0x8E,0x95,0x8F,0x80,0xAD,0xED,0x8A,0x8A,0xA1,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0xE2,0x99,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x97,0x99,0x9A,0x9D,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0xA1,0xE0,0xA3,0xA3,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xBD,0xBE,0xC6,0xC7,0xA5,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE5,0xE5,0xE6,0xE3,0xE8,0xE8,0xEA,0xEA,0xEE,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 850 /* Multilingual Latin 1 (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x9A,0x90,0xB6,0x8E,0xB7,0x8F,0x80,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD8,0xD7,0xDE,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0xE2,0x99,0xE3,0xEA,0xEB,0x59,0x99,0x9A,0x9D,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xB5,0xD6,0xE0,0xE9,0xA5,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0x21,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC7,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE5,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE7,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xED,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 852 /* Latin 2 (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x9A,0x90,0xB6,0x8E,0xDE,0x8F,0x80,0x9D,0xD3,0x8A,0x8A,0xD7,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x91,0xE2,0x99,0x95,0x95,0x97,0x97,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9B,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xB5,0xD6,0xE0,0xE9,0xA4,0xA4,0xA6,0xA6,0xA8,0xA8,0xAA,0x8D,0xAC,0xB8,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBD,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC6,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD1,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD2,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xB7,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE3,0xD5,0xE6,0xE6,0xE8,0xE9,0xE8,0xEB,0xED,0xED,0xDD,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xEB,0xFC,0xFC,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 855 /* Cyrillic (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x81,0x81,0x83,0x83,0x85,0x85,0x87,0x87,0x89,0x89,0x8B,0x8B,0x8D,0x8D,0x8F,0x8F,0x91,0x91,0x93,0x93,0x95,0x95,0x97,0x97,0x99,0x99,0x9B,0x9B,0x9D,0x9D,0x9F,0x9F, \ + 0xA1,0xA1,0xA3,0xA3,0xA5,0xA5,0xA7,0xA7,0xA9,0xA9,0xAB,0xAB,0xAD,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB6,0xB6,0xB8,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBE,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC7,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD1,0xD1,0xD3,0xD3,0xD5,0xD5,0xD7,0xD7,0xDD,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xE0,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE2,0xE2,0xE4,0xE4,0xE6,0xE6,0xE8,0xE8,0xEA,0xEA,0xEC,0xEC,0xEE,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF2,0xF2,0xF4,0xF4,0xF6,0xF6,0xF8,0xF8,0xFA,0xFA,0xFC,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 857 /* Turkish (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x9A,0x90,0xB6,0x8E,0xB7,0x8F,0x80,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD8,0xD7,0x98,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0xE2,0x99,0xE3,0xEA,0xEB,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9D,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9E, \ + 0xB5,0xD6,0xE0,0xE9,0xA5,0xA5,0xA6,0xA6,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0x21,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC7,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE5,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE8,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xDE,0x59,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 858 /* Multilingual Latin 1 + Euro (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x9A,0x90,0xB6,0x8E,0xB7,0x8F,0x80,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD8,0xD7,0xDE,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0xE2,0x99,0xE3,0xEA,0xEB,0x59,0x99,0x9A,0x9D,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xB5,0xD6,0xE0,0xE9,0xA5,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0x21,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC7,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD1,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE5,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE7,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xED,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 862 /* Hebrew (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0x41,0x49,0x4F,0x55,0xA5,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0x21,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE4,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE8,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 866 /* Russian (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x9d,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F,0xF0,0xF0,0xF2,0xF2,0xF4,0xF4,0xF6,0xF6,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 874 /* Thai (OEM, Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0xA1,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE4,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE8,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1250 /* Central Europe (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x8A,0x9B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F, \ + 0xA0,0xA1,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xA3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xA5,0xAA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBC,0xAF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xF7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1251 /* Cyrillic (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x82,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x80,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x8A,0x9B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F, \ + 0xA0,0xA2,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB2,0xA5,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xA8,0xB9,0xAA,0xBB,0xA3,0xBD,0xBD,0xAF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1252 /* Latin 1 (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0xAd,0x9B,0x8C,0x9D,0xAE,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0x21,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xF7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0x9F} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1253 /* Greek (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0xA1,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xA2,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA, \ + 0xE0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xF2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xFB,0xBC,0xFD,0xBF,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1254 /* Turkish (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x8A,0x9B,0x8C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0x21,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xF7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0x9F} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1255 /* Hebrew (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0x21,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE4,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE8,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1256 /* Arabic (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x8C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0xA1,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0x41,0xE1,0x41,0xE3,0xE4,0xE5,0xE6,0x43,0x45,0x45,0x45,0x45,0xEC,0xED,0x49,0x49,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0x4F,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0x55,0xFA,0x55,0x55,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1257 /* Baltic (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0xA1,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xA8,0xB9,0xAA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xAF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xF7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1258 /* Vietnam (OEM, Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0xAC,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0x21,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xEC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xF2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xF7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xFE,0x9F} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1 /* ASCII (for only non-LFN cfg) */ +#if _USE_LFN +#error Cannot use LFN feature without valid code page. +#endif +#define _DF1S 0 + +#else +#error Unknown code page + +#endif + + +/* Character code support macros */ +#define IsUpper(c) (((c)>='A')&&((c)<='Z')) +#define IsLower(c) (((c)>='a')&&((c)<='z')) +#define IsDigit(c) (((c)>='0')&&((c)<='9')) + +#if _DF1S /* Code page is DBCS */ + +#ifdef _DF2S /* Two 1st byte areas */ +#define IsDBCS1(c) (((BYTE)(c) >= _DF1S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DF1E) || ((BYTE)(c) >= _DF2S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DF2E)) +#else /* One 1st byte area */ +#define IsDBCS1(c) ((BYTE)(c) >= _DF1S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DF1E) +#endif + +#ifdef _DS3S /* Three 2nd byte areas */ +#define IsDBCS2(c) (((BYTE)(c) >= _DS1S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DS1E) || ((BYTE)(c) >= _DS2S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DS2E) || ((BYTE)(c) >= _DS3S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DS3E)) +#else /* Two 2nd byte areas */ +#define IsDBCS2(c) (((BYTE)(c) >= _DS1S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DS1E) || ((BYTE)(c) >= _DS2S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DS2E)) +#endif + +#else /* Code page is SBCS */ + +#define IsDBCS1(c) 0 +#define IsDBCS2(c) 0 + +#endif /* _DF1S */ + + +/* Name status flags */ +#define NS 11 /* Index of name status byte in fn[] */ +#define NS_LOSS 0x01 /* Out of 8.3 format */ +#define NS_LFN 0x02 /* Force to create LFN entry */ +#define NS_LAST 0x04 /* Last segment */ +#define NS_BODY 0x08 /* Lower case flag (body) */ +#define NS_EXT 0x10 /* Lower case flag (ext) */ +#define NS_DOT 0x20 /* Dot entry */ + + +/* FAT sub-type boundaries */ +/* Note that the FAT spec by Microsoft says 4085 but Windows works with 4087! */ +#define MIN_FAT16 4086 /* Minimum number of clusters for FAT16 */ +#define MIN_FAT32 65526 /* Minimum number of clusters for FAT32 */ + + +/* FatFs refers the members in the FAT structures as byte array instead of +/ structure member because the structure is not binary compatible between +/ different platforms */ + +#define BS_jmpBoot 0 /* Jump instruction (3) */ +#define BS_OEMName 3 /* OEM name (8) */ +#define BPB_BytsPerSec 11 /* Sector size [byte] (2) */ +#define BPB_SecPerClus 13 /* Cluster size [sector] (1) */ +#define BPB_RsvdSecCnt 14 /* Size of reserved area [sector] (2) */ +#define BPB_NumFATs 16 /* Number of FAT copies (1) */ +#define BPB_RootEntCnt 17 /* Number of root dir entries for FAT12/16 (2) */ +#define BPB_TotSec16 19 /* Volume size [sector] (2) */ +#define BPB_Media 21 /* Media descriptor (1) */ +#define BPB_FATSz16 22 /* FAT size [sector] (2) */ +#define BPB_SecPerTrk 24 /* Track size [sector] (2) */ +#define BPB_NumHeads 26 /* Number of heads (2) */ +#define BPB_HiddSec 28 /* Number of special hidden sectors (4) */ +#define BPB_TotSec32 32 /* Volume size [sector] (4) */ +#define BS_DrvNum 36 /* Physical drive number (2) */ +#define BS_BootSig 38 /* Extended boot signature (1) */ +#define BS_VolID 39 /* Volume serial number (4) */ +#define BS_VolLab 43 /* Volume label (8) */ +#define BS_FilSysType 54 /* File system type (1) */ +#define BPB_FATSz32 36 /* FAT size [sector] (4) */ +#define BPB_ExtFlags 40 /* Extended flags (2) */ +#define BPB_FSVer 42 /* File system version (2) */ +#define BPB_RootClus 44 /* Root dir first cluster (4) */ +#define BPB_FSInfo 48 /* Offset of FSInfo sector (2) */ +#define BPB_BkBootSec 50 /* Offset of backup boot sector (2) */ +#define BS_DrvNum32 64 /* Physical drive number (2) */ +#define BS_BootSig32 66 /* Extended boot signature (1) */ +#define BS_VolID32 67 /* Volume serial number (4) */ +#define BS_VolLab32 71 /* Volume label (8) */ +#define BS_FilSysType32 82 /* File system type (1) */ +#define FSI_LeadSig 0 /* FSI: Leading signature (4) */ +#define FSI_StrucSig 484 /* FSI: Structure signature (4) */ +#define FSI_Free_Count 488 /* FSI: Number of free clusters (4) */ +#define FSI_Nxt_Free 492 /* FSI: Last allocated cluster (4) */ +#define MBR_Table 446 /* MBR: Partition table offset (2) */ +#define SZ_PTE 16 /* MBR: Size of a partition table entry */ +#define BS_55AA 510 /* Boot sector signature (2) */ + +#define DIR_Name 0 /* Short file name (11) */ +#define DIR_Attr 11 /* Attribute (1) */ +#define DIR_NTres 12 /* NT flag (1) */ +#define DIR_CrtTimeTenth 13 /* Created time sub-second (1) */ +#define DIR_CrtTime 14 /* Created time (2) */ +#define DIR_CrtDate 16 /* Created date (2) */ +#define DIR_LstAccDate 18 /* Last accessed date (2) */ +#define DIR_FstClusHI 20 /* Higher 16-bit of first cluster (2) */ +#define DIR_WrtTime 22 /* Modified time (2) */ +#define DIR_WrtDate 24 /* Modified date (2) */ +#define DIR_FstClusLO 26 /* Lower 16-bit of first cluster (2) */ +#define DIR_FileSize 28 /* File size (4) */ +#define LDIR_Ord 0 /* LFN entry order and LLE flag (1) */ +#define LDIR_Attr 11 /* LFN attribute (1) */ +#define LDIR_Type 12 /* LFN type (1) */ +#define LDIR_Chksum 13 /* Sum of corresponding SFN entry */ +#define LDIR_FstClusLO 26 /* Filled by zero (0) */ +#define SZ_DIR 32 /* Size of a directory entry */ +#define LLE 0x40 /* Last long entry flag in LDIR_Ord */ +#define DDE 0xE5 /* Deleted directory entry mark in DIR_Name[0] */ +#define NDDE 0x05 /* Replacement of the character collides with DDE */ + + +/*------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Module private work area */ +/*------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Note that uninitialized variables with static duration are +/ zeroed/nulled at start-up. If not, the compiler or start-up +/ routine is out of ANSI-C standard. +*/ + +#if _VOLUMES +static +FATFS *FatFs[_VOLUMES]; /* Pointer to the file system objects (logical drives) */ +#else +#error Number of volumes must not be 0. +#endif + +static +WORD Fsid; /* File system mount ID */ + +#if _FS_RPATH +static +BYTE CurrVol; /* Current drive */ +#endif + +#if _FS_LOCK +static +FILESEM Files[_FS_LOCK]; /* File lock semaphores */ +#endif + +#if _USE_LFN == 0 /* No LFN feature */ +#define DEF_NAMEBUF BYTE sfn[12] +#define INIT_BUF(dobj) (dobj).fn = sfn +#define FREE_BUF() + +#elif _USE_LFN == 1 /* LFN feature with static working buffer */ +static WCHAR LfnBuf[_MAX_LFN+1]; +#define DEF_NAMEBUF BYTE sfn[12] +#define INIT_BUF(dobj) { (dobj).fn = sfn; (dobj).lfn = LfnBuf; } +#define FREE_BUF() + +#elif _USE_LFN == 2 /* LFN feature with dynamic working buffer on the stack */ +#define DEF_NAMEBUF BYTE sfn[12]; WCHAR lbuf[_MAX_LFN+1] +#define INIT_BUF(dobj) { (dobj).fn = sfn; (dobj).lfn = lbuf; } +#define FREE_BUF() + +#elif _USE_LFN == 3 /* LFN feature with dynamic working buffer on the heap */ +#define DEF_NAMEBUF BYTE sfn[12]; WCHAR *lfn +#define INIT_BUF(dobj) { lfn = ff_memalloc((_MAX_LFN + 1) * 2); \ + if (!lfn) LEAVE_FF((dobj).fs, FR_NOT_ENOUGH_CORE); \ + (dobj).lfn = lfn; (dobj).fn = sfn; } +#define FREE_BUF() ff_memfree(lfn) + +#else +#error Wrong LFN configuration. +#endif + + + + +/*-------------------------------------------------------------------------- + + Module Private Functions + +---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* String functions */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +/* Copy memory to memory */ +static +void mem_cpy (void* dst, const void* src, UINT cnt) { + BYTE *d = (BYTE*)dst; + const BYTE *s = (const BYTE*)src; + +#if _WORD_ACCESS == 1 + while (cnt >= sizeof (int)) { + *(int*)d = *(int*)s; + d += sizeof (int); s += sizeof (int); + cnt -= sizeof (int); + } +#endif + while (cnt--) + *d++ = *s++; +} + +/* Fill memory */ +static +void mem_set (void* dst, int val, UINT cnt) { + BYTE *d = (BYTE*)dst; + + while (cnt--) + *d++ = (BYTE)val; +} + +/* Compare memory to memory */ +static +int mem_cmp (const void* dst, const void* src, UINT cnt) { + const BYTE *d = (const BYTE *)dst, *s = (const BYTE *)src; + int r = 0; + + while (cnt-- && (r = *d++ - *s++) == 0) ; + return r; +} + +/* Check if chr is contained in the string */ +static +int chk_chr (const char* str, int chr) { + while (*str && *str != chr) str++; + return *str; +} + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Request/Release grant to access the volume */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _FS_REENTRANT + +static +int lock_fs ( + FATFS *fs /* File system object */ +) +{ + return ff_req_grant(fs->sobj); +} + + +static +void unlock_fs ( + FATFS *fs, /* File system object */ + FRESULT res /* Result code to be returned */ +) +{ + if (fs && + res != FR_NOT_ENABLED && + res != FR_INVALID_DRIVE && + res != FR_INVALID_OBJECT && + res != FR_TIMEOUT) { + ff_rel_grant(fs->sobj); + } +} +#endif + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* File lock control functions */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _FS_LOCK + +static +FRESULT chk_lock ( /* Check if the file can be accessed */ + DIR* dj, /* Directory object pointing the file to be checked */ + int acc /* Desired access (0:Read, 1:Write, 2:Delete/Rename) */ +) +{ + UINT i, be; + + /* Search file semaphore table */ + for (i = be = 0; i < _FS_LOCK; i++) { + if (Files[i].fs) { /* Existing entry */ + if (Files[i].fs == dj->fs && /* Check if the file matched with an open file */ + Files[i].clu == dj->sclust && + Files[i].idx == dj->index) break; + } else { /* Blank entry */ + be++; + } + } + if (i == _FS_LOCK) /* The file is not opened */ + return (be || acc == 2) ? FR_OK : FR_TOO_MANY_OPEN_FILES; /* Is there a blank entry for new file? */ + + /* The file has been opened. Reject any open against writing file and all write mode open */ + return (acc || Files[i].ctr == 0x100) ? FR_LOCKED : FR_OK; +} + + +static +int enq_lock (void) /* Check if an entry is available for a new file */ +{ + UINT i; + + for (i = 0; i < _FS_LOCK && Files[i].fs; i++) ; + return (i == _FS_LOCK) ? 0 : 1; +} + + +static +UINT inc_lock ( /* Increment file open counter and returns its index (0:int error) */ + DIR* dj, /* Directory object pointing the file to register or increment */ + int acc /* Desired access mode (0:Read, !0:Write) */ +) +{ + UINT i; + + + for (i = 0; i < _FS_LOCK; i++) { /* Find the file */ + if (Files[i].fs == dj->fs && + Files[i].clu == dj->sclust && + Files[i].idx == dj->index) break; + } + + if (i == _FS_LOCK) { /* Not opened. Register it as new. */ + for (i = 0; i < _FS_LOCK && Files[i].fs; i++) ; + if (i == _FS_LOCK) return 0; /* No space to register (int err) */ + Files[i].fs = dj->fs; + Files[i].clu = dj->sclust; + Files[i].idx = dj->index; + Files[i].ctr = 0; + } + + if (acc && Files[i].ctr) return 0; /* Access violation (int err) */ + + Files[i].ctr = acc ? 0x100 : Files[i].ctr + 1; /* Set semaphore value */ + + return i + 1; +} + + +static +FRESULT dec_lock ( /* Decrement file open counter */ + UINT i /* Semaphore index */ +) +{ + WORD n; + FRESULT res; + + + if (--i < _FS_LOCK) { + n = Files[i].ctr; + if (n == 0x100) n = 0; + if (n) n--; + Files[i].ctr = n; + if (!n) Files[i].fs = 0; + res = FR_OK; + } else { + res = FR_INT_ERR; + } + return res; +} + + +static +void clear_lock ( /* Clear lock entries of the volume */ + FATFS *fs +) +{ + UINT i; + + for (i = 0; i < _FS_LOCK; i++) { + if (Files[i].fs == fs) Files[i].fs = 0; + } +} +#endif + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Change window offset */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT move_window ( + FATFS *fs, /* File system object */ + DWORD sector /* Sector number to make appearance in the fs->win[] */ +) /* Move to zero only writes back dirty window */ +{ + DWORD wsect; + + + wsect = fs->winsect; + if (wsect != sector) { /* Changed current window */ +#if !_FS_READONLY + if (fs->wflag) { /* Write back dirty window if needed */ + if (disk_write(fs->drv, fs->win, wsect, 1) != RES_OK) + return FR_DISK_ERR; + fs->wflag = 0; + if (wsect < (fs->fatbase + fs->fsize)) { /* In FAT area */ + BYTE nf; + for (nf = fs->n_fats; nf > 1; nf--) { /* Reflect the change to all FAT copies */ + wsect += fs->fsize; + disk_write(fs->drv, fs->win, wsect, 1); + } + } + } +#endif + if (sector) { + if (disk_read(fs->drv, fs->win, sector, 1) != RES_OK) + return FR_DISK_ERR; + fs->winsect = sector; + } + } + + return FR_OK; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Clean-up cached data */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if !_FS_READONLY +static +FRESULT sync ( /* FR_OK: successful, FR_DISK_ERR: failed */ + FATFS *fs /* File system object */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + + + res = move_window(fs, 0); + if (res == FR_OK) { + /* Update FSInfo sector if needed */ + if (fs->fs_type == FS_FAT32 && fs->fsi_flag) { + fs->winsect = 0; + /* Create FSInfo structure */ + mem_set(fs->win, 0, 512); + ST_WORD(fs->win+BS_55AA, 0xAA55); + ST_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_LeadSig, 0x41615252); + ST_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_StrucSig, 0x61417272); + ST_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_Free_Count, fs->free_clust); + ST_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_Nxt_Free, fs->last_clust); + /* Write it into the FSInfo sector */ + disk_write(fs->drv, fs->win, fs->fsi_sector, 1); + fs->fsi_flag = 0; + } + /* Make sure that no pending write process in the physical drive */ + if (disk_ioctl(fs->drv, CTRL_SYNC, 0) != RES_OK) + res = FR_DISK_ERR; + } + + return res; +} +#endif + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Get sector# from cluster# */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + + +DWORD clust2sect ( /* !=0: Sector number, 0: Failed - invalid cluster# */ + FATFS *fs, /* File system object */ + DWORD clst /* Cluster# to be converted */ +) +{ + clst -= 2; + if (clst >= (fs->n_fatent - 2)) return 0; /* Invalid cluster# */ + return clst * fs->csize + fs->database; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* FAT access - Read value of a FAT entry */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + + +DWORD get_fat ( /* 0xFFFFFFFF:Disk error, 1:Internal error, Else:Cluster status */ + FATFS *fs, /* File system object */ + DWORD clst /* Cluster# to get the link information */ +) +{ + UINT wc, bc; + BYTE *p; + + + if (clst < 2 || clst >= fs->n_fatent) /* Check range */ + return 1; + + switch (fs->fs_type) { + case FS_FAT12 : + bc = (UINT)clst; bc += bc / 2; + if (move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (bc / SS(fs)))) break; + wc = fs->win[bc % SS(fs)]; bc++; + if (move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (bc / SS(fs)))) break; + wc |= fs->win[bc % SS(fs)] << 8; + return (clst & 1) ? (wc >> 4) : (wc & 0xFFF); + + case FS_FAT16 : + if (move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (clst / (SS(fs) / 2)))) break; + p = &fs->win[clst * 2 % SS(fs)]; + return LD_WORD(p); + + case FS_FAT32 : + if (move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (clst / (SS(fs) / 4)))) break; + p = &fs->win[clst * 4 % SS(fs)]; + return LD_DWORD(p) & 0x0FFFFFFF; + } + + return 0xFFFFFFFF; /* An error occurred at the disk I/O layer */ +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* FAT access - Change value of a FAT entry */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if !_FS_READONLY + +FRESULT put_fat ( + FATFS *fs, /* File system object */ + DWORD clst, /* Cluster# to be changed in range of 2 to fs->n_fatent - 1 */ + DWORD val /* New value to mark the cluster */ +) +{ + UINT bc; + BYTE *p; + FRESULT res; + + + if (clst < 2 || clst >= fs->n_fatent) { /* Check range */ + res = FR_INT_ERR; + + } else { + switch (fs->fs_type) { + case FS_FAT12 : + bc = (UINT)clst; bc += bc / 2; + res = move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (bc / SS(fs))); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + p = &fs->win[bc % SS(fs)]; + *p = (clst & 1) ? ((*p & 0x0F) | ((BYTE)val << 4)) : (BYTE)val; + bc++; + fs->wflag = 1; + res = move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (bc / SS(fs))); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + p = &fs->win[bc % SS(fs)]; + *p = (clst & 1) ? (BYTE)(val >> 4) : ((*p & 0xF0) | ((BYTE)(val >> 8) & 0x0F)); + break; + + case FS_FAT16 : + res = move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (clst / (SS(fs) / 2))); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + p = &fs->win[clst * 2 % SS(fs)]; + ST_WORD(p, (WORD)val); + break; + + case FS_FAT32 : + res = move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (clst / (SS(fs) / 4))); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + p = &fs->win[clst * 4 % SS(fs)]; + val |= LD_DWORD(p) & 0xF0000000; + ST_DWORD(p, val); + break; + + default : + res = FR_INT_ERR; + } + fs->wflag = 1; + } + + return res; +} +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* FAT handling - Remove a cluster chain */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if !_FS_READONLY +static +FRESULT remove_chain ( + FATFS *fs, /* File system object */ + DWORD clst /* Cluster# to remove a chain from */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DWORD nxt; +#if _USE_ERASE + DWORD scl = clst, ecl = clst, rt[2]; +#endif + + if (clst < 2 || clst >= fs->n_fatent) { /* Check range */ + res = FR_INT_ERR; + + } else { + res = FR_OK; + while (clst < fs->n_fatent) { /* Not a last link? */ + nxt = get_fat(fs, clst); /* Get cluster status */ + if (nxt == 0) break; /* Empty cluster? */ + if (nxt == 1) { res = FR_INT_ERR; break; } /* Internal error? */ + if (nxt == 0xFFFFFFFF) { res = FR_DISK_ERR; break; } /* Disk error? */ + res = put_fat(fs, clst, 0); /* Mark the cluster "empty" */ + if (res != FR_OK) break; + if (fs->free_clust != 0xFFFFFFFF) { /* Update FSInfo */ + fs->free_clust++; + fs->fsi_flag = 1; + } +#if _USE_ERASE + if (ecl + 1 == nxt) { /* Is next cluster contiguous? */ + ecl = nxt; + } else { /* End of contiguous clusters */ + rt[0] = clust2sect(fs, scl); /* Start sector */ + rt[1] = clust2sect(fs, ecl) + fs->csize - 1; /* End sector */ + disk_ioctl(fs->drv, CTRL_ERASE_SECTOR, rt); /* Erase the block */ + scl = ecl = nxt; + } +#endif + clst = nxt; /* Next cluster */ + } + } + + return res; +} +#endif + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* FAT handling - Stretch or Create a cluster chain */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if !_FS_READONLY +static +DWORD create_chain ( /* 0:No free cluster, 1:Internal error, 0xFFFFFFFF:Disk error, >=2:New cluster# */ + FATFS *fs, /* File system object */ + DWORD clst /* Cluster# to stretch. 0 means create a new chain. */ +) +{ + DWORD cs, ncl, scl; + FRESULT res; + + + if (clst == 0) { /* Create a new chain */ + scl = fs->last_clust; /* Get suggested start point */ + if (!scl || scl >= fs->n_fatent) scl = 1; + } + else { /* Stretch the current chain */ + cs = get_fat(fs, clst); /* Check the cluster status */ + if (cs < 2) return 1; /* It is an invalid cluster */ + if (cs < fs->n_fatent) return cs; /* It is already followed by next cluster */ + scl = clst; + } + + ncl = scl; /* Start cluster */ + for (;;) { + ncl++; /* Next cluster */ + if (ncl >= fs->n_fatent) { /* Wrap around */ + ncl = 2; + if (ncl > scl) return 0; /* No free cluster */ + } + cs = get_fat(fs, ncl); /* Get the cluster status */ + if (cs == 0) break; /* Found a free cluster */ + if (cs == 0xFFFFFFFF || cs == 1)/* An error occurred */ + return cs; + if (ncl == scl) return 0; /* No free cluster */ + } + + res = put_fat(fs, ncl, 0x0FFFFFFF); /* Mark the new cluster "last link" */ + if (res == FR_OK && clst != 0) { + res = put_fat(fs, clst, ncl); /* Link it to the previous one if needed */ + } + if (res == FR_OK) { + fs->last_clust = ncl; /* Update FSINFO */ + if (fs->free_clust != 0xFFFFFFFF) { + fs->free_clust--; + fs->fsi_flag = 1; + } + } else { + ncl = (res == FR_DISK_ERR) ? 0xFFFFFFFF : 1; + } + + return ncl; /* Return new cluster number or error code */ +} +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* FAT handling - Convert offset into cluster with link map table */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#if _USE_FASTSEEK +static +DWORD clmt_clust ( /* <2:Error, >=2:Cluster number */ + FIL* fp, /* Pointer to the file object */ + DWORD ofs /* File offset to be converted to cluster# */ +) +{ + DWORD cl, ncl, *tbl; + + + tbl = fp->cltbl + 1; /* Top of CLMT */ + cl = ofs / SS(fp->fs) / fp->fs->csize; /* Cluster order from top of the file */ + for (;;) { + ncl = *tbl++; /* Number of cluters in the fragment */ + if (!ncl) return 0; /* End of table? (error) */ + if (cl < ncl) break; /* In this fragment? */ + cl -= ncl; tbl++; /* Next fragment */ + } + return cl + *tbl; /* Return the cluster number */ +} +#endif /* _USE_FASTSEEK */ + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Directory handling - Set directory index */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT dir_sdi ( + DIR *dj, /* Pointer to directory object */ + WORD idx /* Index of directory table */ +) +{ + DWORD clst; + WORD ic; + + + dj->index = idx; + clst = dj->sclust; + if (clst == 1 || clst >= dj->fs->n_fatent) /* Check start cluster range */ + return FR_INT_ERR; + if (!clst && dj->fs->fs_type == FS_FAT32) /* Replace cluster# 0 with root cluster# if in FAT32 */ + clst = dj->fs->dirbase; + + if (clst == 0) { /* Static table (root-dir in FAT12/16) */ + dj->clust = clst; + if (idx >= dj->fs->n_rootdir) /* Index is out of range */ + return FR_INT_ERR; + dj->sect = dj->fs->dirbase + idx / (SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR); /* Sector# */ + } + else { /* Dynamic table (sub-dirs or root-dir in FAT32) */ + ic = SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR * dj->fs->csize; /* Entries per cluster */ + while (idx >= ic) { /* Follow cluster chain */ + clst = get_fat(dj->fs, clst); /* Get next cluster */ + if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) return FR_DISK_ERR; /* Disk error */ + if (clst < 2 || clst >= dj->fs->n_fatent) /* Reached to end of table or int error */ + return FR_INT_ERR; + idx -= ic; + } + dj->clust = clst; + dj->sect = clust2sect(dj->fs, clst) + idx / (SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR); /* Sector# */ + } + + dj->dir = dj->fs->win + (idx % (SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR)) * SZ_DIR; /* Ptr to the entry in the sector */ + + return FR_OK; /* Seek succeeded */ +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Directory handling - Move directory table index next */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT dir_next ( /* FR_OK:Succeeded, FR_NO_FILE:End of table, FR_DENIED:EOT and could not stretch */ + DIR *dj, /* Pointer to directory object */ + int stretch /* 0: Do not stretch table, 1: Stretch table if needed */ +) +{ + DWORD clst; + WORD i; + + + stretch = stretch; /* To suppress warning on read-only cfg. */ + i = dj->index + 1; + if (!i || !dj->sect) /* Report EOT when index has reached 65535 */ + return FR_NO_FILE; + + if (!(i % (SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR))) { /* Sector changed? */ + dj->sect++; /* Next sector */ + + if (dj->clust == 0) { /* Static table */ + if (i >= dj->fs->n_rootdir) /* Report EOT when end of table */ + return FR_NO_FILE; + } + else { /* Dynamic table */ + if (((i / (SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR)) & (dj->fs->csize - 1)) == 0) { /* Cluster changed? */ + clst = get_fat(dj->fs, dj->clust); /* Get next cluster */ + if (clst <= 1) return FR_INT_ERR; + if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) return FR_DISK_ERR; + if (clst >= dj->fs->n_fatent) { /* When it reached end of dynamic table */ +#if !_FS_READONLY + BYTE c; + if (!stretch) return FR_NO_FILE; /* When do not stretch, report EOT */ + clst = create_chain(dj->fs, dj->clust); /* Stretch cluster chain */ + if (clst == 0) return FR_DENIED; /* No free cluster */ + if (clst == 1) return FR_INT_ERR; + if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) return FR_DISK_ERR; + /* Clean-up stretched table */ + if (move_window(dj->fs, 0)) return FR_DISK_ERR; /* Flush active window */ + mem_set(dj->fs->win, 0, SS(dj->fs)); /* Clear window buffer */ + dj->fs->winsect = clust2sect(dj->fs, clst); /* Cluster start sector */ + for (c = 0; c < dj->fs->csize; c++) { /* Fill the new cluster with 0 */ + dj->fs->wflag = 1; + if (move_window(dj->fs, 0)) return FR_DISK_ERR; + dj->fs->winsect++; + } + dj->fs->winsect -= c; /* Rewind window address */ +#else + return FR_NO_FILE; /* Report EOT */ +#endif + } + dj->clust = clst; /* Initialize data for new cluster */ + dj->sect = clust2sect(dj->fs, clst); + } + } + } + + dj->index = i; + dj->dir = dj->fs->win + (i % (SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR)) * SZ_DIR; + + return FR_OK; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Directory handling - Load/Store start cluster number */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +DWORD ld_clust ( + FATFS *fs, /* Pointer to the fs object */ + BYTE *dir /* Pointer to the directory entry */ +) +{ + DWORD cl; + + cl = LD_WORD(dir+DIR_FstClusLO); + if (fs->fs_type == FS_FAT32) + cl |= (DWORD)LD_WORD(dir+DIR_FstClusHI) << 16; + + return cl; +} + + +#if !_FS_READONLY +static +void st_clust ( + BYTE *dir, /* Pointer to the directory entry */ + DWORD cl /* Value to be set */ +) +{ + ST_WORD(dir+DIR_FstClusLO, cl); + ST_WORD(dir+DIR_FstClusHI, cl >> 16); +} +#endif + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* LFN handling - Test/Pick/Fit an LFN segment from/to directory entry */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _USE_LFN +static +const BYTE LfnOfs[] = {1,3,5,7,9,14,16,18,20,22,24,28,30}; /* Offset of LFN chars in the directory entry */ + + +static +int cmp_lfn ( /* 1:Matched, 0:Not matched */ + WCHAR *lfnbuf, /* Pointer to the LFN to be compared */ + BYTE *dir /* Pointer to the directory entry containing a part of LFN */ +) +{ + UINT i, s; + WCHAR wc, uc; + + + i = ((dir[LDIR_Ord] & ~LLE) - 1) * 13; /* Get offset in the LFN buffer */ + s = 0; wc = 1; + do { + uc = LD_WORD(dir+LfnOfs[s]); /* Pick an LFN character from the entry */ + if (wc) { /* Last char has not been processed */ + wc = ff_wtoupper(uc); /* Convert it to upper case */ + if (i >= _MAX_LFN || wc != ff_wtoupper(lfnbuf[i++])) /* Compare it */ + return 0; /* Not matched */ + } else { + if (uc != 0xFFFF) return 0; /* Check filler */ + } + } while (++s < 13); /* Repeat until all chars in the entry are checked */ + + if ((dir[LDIR_Ord] & LLE) && wc && lfnbuf[i]) /* Last segment matched but different length */ + return 0; + + return 1; /* The part of LFN matched */ +} + + + +static +int pick_lfn ( /* 1:Succeeded, 0:Buffer overflow */ + WCHAR *lfnbuf, /* Pointer to the Unicode-LFN buffer */ + BYTE *dir /* Pointer to the directory entry */ +) +{ + UINT i, s; + WCHAR wc, uc; + + + i = ((dir[LDIR_Ord] & 0x3F) - 1) * 13; /* Offset in the LFN buffer */ + + s = 0; wc = 1; + do { + uc = LD_WORD(dir+LfnOfs[s]); /* Pick an LFN character from the entry */ + if (wc) { /* Last char has not been processed */ + if (i >= _MAX_LFN) return 0; /* Buffer overflow? */ + lfnbuf[i++] = wc = uc; /* Store it */ + } else { + if (uc != 0xFFFF) return 0; /* Check filler */ + } + } while (++s < 13); /* Read all character in the entry */ + + if (dir[LDIR_Ord] & LLE) { /* Put terminator if it is the last LFN part */ + if (i >= _MAX_LFN) return 0; /* Buffer overflow? */ + lfnbuf[i] = 0; + } + + return 1; +} + + +#if !_FS_READONLY +static +void fit_lfn ( + const WCHAR *lfnbuf, /* Pointer to the LFN buffer */ + BYTE *dir, /* Pointer to the directory entry */ + BYTE ord, /* LFN order (1-20) */ + BYTE sum /* SFN sum */ +) +{ + UINT i, s; + WCHAR wc; + + + dir[LDIR_Chksum] = sum; /* Set check sum */ + dir[LDIR_Attr] = AM_LFN; /* Set attribute. LFN entry */ + dir[LDIR_Type] = 0; + ST_WORD(dir+LDIR_FstClusLO, 0); + + i = (ord - 1) * 13; /* Get offset in the LFN buffer */ + s = wc = 0; + do { + if (wc != 0xFFFF) wc = lfnbuf[i++]; /* Get an effective char */ + ST_WORD(dir+LfnOfs[s], wc); /* Put it */ + if (!wc) wc = 0xFFFF; /* Padding chars following last char */ + } while (++s < 13); + if (wc == 0xFFFF || !lfnbuf[i]) ord |= LLE; /* Bottom LFN part is the start of LFN sequence */ + dir[LDIR_Ord] = ord; /* Set the LFN order */ +} + +#endif +#endif + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Create numbered name */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _USE_LFN +void gen_numname ( + BYTE *dst, /* Pointer to generated SFN */ + const BYTE *src, /* Pointer to source SFN to be modified */ + const WCHAR *lfn, /* Pointer to LFN */ + WORD seq /* Sequence number */ +) +{ + BYTE ns[8], c; + UINT i, j; + + + mem_cpy(dst, src, 11); + + if (seq > 5) { /* On many collisions, generate a hash number instead of sequential number */ + do seq = (seq >> 1) + (seq << 15) + (WORD)*lfn++; while (*lfn); + } + + /* itoa (hexdecimal) */ + i = 7; + do { + c = (seq % 16) + '0'; + if (c > '9') c += 7; + ns[i--] = c; + seq /= 16; + } while (seq); + ns[i] = '~'; + + /* Append the number */ + for (j = 0; j < i && dst[j] != ' '; j++) { + if (IsDBCS1(dst[j])) { + if (j == i - 1) break; + j++; + } + } + do { + dst[j++] = (i < 8) ? ns[i++] : ' '; + } while (j < 8); +} +#endif + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Calculate sum of an SFN */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _USE_LFN +static +BYTE sum_sfn ( + const BYTE *dir /* Ptr to directory entry */ +) +{ + BYTE sum = 0; + UINT n = 11; + + do sum = (sum >> 1) + (sum << 7) + *dir++; while (--n); + return sum; +} +#endif + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Directory handling - Find an object in the directory */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT dir_find ( + DIR *dj /* Pointer to the directory object linked to the file name */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + BYTE c, *dir; +#if _USE_LFN + BYTE a, ord, sum; +#endif + + res = dir_sdi(dj, 0); /* Rewind directory object */ + if (res != FR_OK) return res; + +#if _USE_LFN + ord = sum = 0xFF; +#endif + do { + res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + dir = dj->dir; /* Ptr to the directory entry of current index */ + c = dir[DIR_Name]; + if (c == 0) { res = FR_NO_FILE; break; } /* Reached to end of table */ +#if _USE_LFN /* LFN configuration */ + a = dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_MASK; + if (c == DDE || ((a & AM_VOL) && a != AM_LFN)) { /* An entry without valid data */ + ord = 0xFF; + } else { + if (a == AM_LFN) { /* An LFN entry is found */ + if (dj->lfn) { + if (c & LLE) { /* Is it start of LFN sequence? */ + sum = dir[LDIR_Chksum]; + c &= ~LLE; ord = c; /* LFN start order */ + dj->lfn_idx = dj->index; + } + /* Check validity of the LFN entry and compare it with given name */ + ord = (c == ord && sum == dir[LDIR_Chksum] && cmp_lfn(dj->lfn, dir)) ? ord - 1 : 0xFF; + } + } else { /* An SFN entry is found */ + if (!ord && sum == sum_sfn(dir)) break; /* LFN matched? */ + ord = 0xFF; dj->lfn_idx = 0xFFFF; /* Reset LFN sequence */ + if (!(dj->fn[NS] & NS_LOSS) && !mem_cmp(dir, dj->fn, 11)) break; /* SFN matched? */ + } + } +#else /* Non LFN configuration */ + if (!(dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_VOL) && !mem_cmp(dir, dj->fn, 11)) /* Is it a valid entry? */ + break; +#endif + res = dir_next(dj, 0); /* Next entry */ + } while (res == FR_OK); + + return res; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Read an object from the directory */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _FS_MINIMIZE <= 1 +static +FRESULT dir_read ( + DIR *dj /* Pointer to the directory object that pointing the entry to be read */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + BYTE c, *dir; +#if _USE_LFN + BYTE a, ord = 0xFF, sum = 0xFF; +#endif + + res = FR_NO_FILE; + while (dj->sect) { + res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + dir = dj->dir; /* Ptr to the directory entry of current index */ + c = dir[DIR_Name]; + if (c == 0) { res = FR_NO_FILE; break; } /* Reached to end of table */ +#if _USE_LFN /* LFN configuration */ + a = dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_MASK; + if (c == DDE || (!_FS_RPATH && c == '.') || ((a & AM_VOL) && a != AM_LFN)) { /* An entry without valid data */ + ord = 0xFF; + } else { + if (a == AM_LFN) { /* An LFN entry is found */ + if (c & LLE) { /* Is it start of LFN sequence? */ + sum = dir[LDIR_Chksum]; + c &= ~LLE; ord = c; + dj->lfn_idx = dj->index; + } + /* Check LFN validity and capture it */ + ord = (c == ord && sum == dir[LDIR_Chksum] && pick_lfn(dj->lfn, dir)) ? ord - 1 : 0xFF; + } else { /* An SFN entry is found */ + if (ord || sum != sum_sfn(dir)) /* Is there a valid LFN? */ + dj->lfn_idx = 0xFFFF; /* It has no LFN. */ + break; + } + } +#else /* Non LFN configuration */ + if (c != DDE && (_FS_RPATH || c != '.') && !(dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_VOL)) /* Is it a valid entry? */ + break; +#endif + res = dir_next(dj, 0); /* Next entry */ + if (res != FR_OK) break; + } + + if (res != FR_OK) dj->sect = 0; + + return res; +} +#endif + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Register an object to the directory */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if !_FS_READONLY +static +FRESULT dir_register ( /* FR_OK:Successful, FR_DENIED:No free entry or too many SFN collision, FR_DISK_ERR:Disk error */ + DIR *dj /* Target directory with object name to be created */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + BYTE c, *dir; +#if _USE_LFN /* LFN configuration */ + WORD n, ne, is; + BYTE sn[12], *fn, sum; + WCHAR *lfn; + + + fn = dj->fn; lfn = dj->lfn; + mem_cpy(sn, fn, 12); + + if (_FS_RPATH && (sn[NS] & NS_DOT)) /* Cannot create dot entry */ + return FR_INVALID_NAME; + + if (sn[NS] & NS_LOSS) { /* When LFN is out of 8.3 format, generate a numbered name */ + fn[NS] = 0; dj->lfn = 0; /* Find only SFN */ + for (n = 1; n < 100; n++) { + gen_numname(fn, sn, lfn, n); /* Generate a numbered name */ + res = dir_find(dj); /* Check if the name collides with existing SFN */ + if (res != FR_OK) break; + } + if (n == 100) return FR_DENIED; /* Abort if too many collisions */ + if (res != FR_NO_FILE) return res; /* Abort if the result is other than 'not collided' */ + fn[NS] = sn[NS]; dj->lfn = lfn; + } + + if (sn[NS] & NS_LFN) { /* When LFN is to be created, reserve an SFN + LFN entries. */ + for (ne = 0; lfn[ne]; ne++) ; + ne = (ne + 25) / 13; + } else { /* Otherwise reserve only an SFN entry. */ + ne = 1; + } + + /* Reserve contiguous entries */ + res = dir_sdi(dj, 0); + if (res != FR_OK) return res; + n = is = 0; + do { + res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + c = *dj->dir; /* Check the entry status */ + if (c == DDE || c == 0) { /* Is it a blank entry? */ + if (n == 0) is = dj->index; /* First index of the contiguous entry */ + if (++n == ne) break; /* A contiguous entry that required count is found */ + } else { + n = 0; /* Not a blank entry. Restart to search */ + } + res = dir_next(dj, 1); /* Next entry with table stretch */ + } while (res == FR_OK); + + if (res == FR_OK && ne > 1) { /* Initialize LFN entry if needed */ + res = dir_sdi(dj, is); + if (res == FR_OK) { + sum = sum_sfn(dj->fn); /* Sum of the SFN tied to the LFN */ + ne--; + do { /* Store LFN entries in bottom first */ + res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + fit_lfn(dj->lfn, dj->dir, (BYTE)ne, sum); + dj->fs->wflag = 1; + res = dir_next(dj, 0); /* Next entry */ + } while (res == FR_OK && --ne); + } + } + +#else /* Non LFN configuration */ + res = dir_sdi(dj, 0); + if (res == FR_OK) { + do { /* Find a blank entry for the SFN */ + res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + c = *dj->dir; + if (c == DDE || c == 0) break; /* Is it a blank entry? */ + res = dir_next(dj, 1); /* Next entry with table stretch */ + } while (res == FR_OK); + } +#endif + + if (res == FR_OK) { /* Initialize the SFN entry */ + res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); + if (res == FR_OK) { + dir = dj->dir; + mem_set(dir, 0, SZ_DIR); /* Clean the entry */ + mem_cpy(dir, dj->fn, 11); /* Put SFN */ +#if _USE_LFN + dir[DIR_NTres] = *(dj->fn+NS) & (NS_BODY | NS_EXT); /* Put NT flag */ +#endif + dj->fs->wflag = 1; + } + } + + return res; +} +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Remove an object from the directory */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if !_FS_READONLY && !_FS_MINIMIZE +static +FRESULT dir_remove ( /* FR_OK: Successful, FR_DISK_ERR: A disk error */ + DIR *dj /* Directory object pointing the entry to be removed */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; +#if _USE_LFN /* LFN configuration */ + WORD i; + + i = dj->index; /* SFN index */ + res = dir_sdi(dj, (WORD)((dj->lfn_idx == 0xFFFF) ? i : dj->lfn_idx)); /* Goto the SFN or top of the LFN entries */ + if (res == FR_OK) { + do { + res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + *dj->dir = DDE; /* Mark the entry "deleted" */ + dj->fs->wflag = 1; + if (dj->index >= i) break; /* When reached SFN, all entries of the object has been deleted. */ + res = dir_next(dj, 0); /* Next entry */ + } while (res == FR_OK); + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) res = FR_INT_ERR; + } + +#else /* Non LFN configuration */ + res = dir_sdi(dj, dj->index); + if (res == FR_OK) { + res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); + if (res == FR_OK) { + *dj->dir = DDE; /* Mark the entry "deleted" */ + dj->fs->wflag = 1; + } + } +#endif + + return res; +} +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Pick a segment and create the object name in directory form */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT create_name ( + DIR *dj, /* Pointer to the directory object */ + const TCHAR **path /* Pointer to pointer to the segment in the path string */ +) +{ +#ifdef _EXCVT + static const BYTE excvt[] = _EXCVT; /* Upper conversion table for extended chars */ +#endif + +#if _USE_LFN /* LFN configuration */ + BYTE b, cf; + WCHAR w, *lfn; + UINT i, ni, si, di; + const TCHAR *p; + + /* Create LFN in Unicode */ + for (p = *path; *p == '/' || *p == '\\'; p++) ; /* Strip duplicated separator */ + lfn = dj->lfn; + si = di = 0; + for (;;) { + w = p[si++]; /* Get a character */ + if (w < ' ' || w == '/' || w == '\\') break; /* Break on end of segment */ + if (di >= _MAX_LFN) /* Reject too long name */ + return FR_INVALID_NAME; +#if !_LFN_UNICODE + w &= 0xFF; + if (IsDBCS1(w)) { /* Check if it is a DBC 1st byte (always false on SBCS cfg) */ + b = (BYTE)p[si++]; /* Get 2nd byte */ + if (!IsDBCS2(b)) + return FR_INVALID_NAME; /* Reject invalid sequence */ + w = (w << 8) + b; /* Create a DBC */ + } + w = ff_convert(w, 1); /* Convert ANSI/OEM to Unicode */ + if (!w) return FR_INVALID_NAME; /* Reject invalid code */ +#endif + if (w < 0x80 && chk_chr("\"*:<>\?|\x7F", w)) /* Reject illegal chars for LFN */ + return FR_INVALID_NAME; + lfn[di++] = w; /* Store the Unicode char */ + } + *path = &p[si]; /* Return pointer to the next segment */ + cf = (w < ' ') ? NS_LAST : 0; /* Set last segment flag if end of path */ +#if _FS_RPATH + if ((di == 1 && lfn[di-1] == '.') || /* Is this a dot entry? */ + (di == 2 && lfn[di-1] == '.' && lfn[di-2] == '.')) { + lfn[di] = 0; + for (i = 0; i < 11; i++) + dj->fn[i] = (i < di) ? '.' : ' '; + dj->fn[i] = cf | NS_DOT; /* This is a dot entry */ + return FR_OK; + } +#endif + while (di) { /* Strip trailing spaces and dots */ + w = lfn[di-1]; + if (w != ' ' && w != '.') break; + di--; + } + if (!di) return FR_INVALID_NAME; /* Reject nul string */ + + lfn[di] = 0; /* LFN is created */ + + /* Create SFN in directory form */ + mem_set(dj->fn, ' ', 11); + for (si = 0; lfn[si] == ' ' || lfn[si] == '.'; si++) ; /* Strip leading spaces and dots */ + if (si) cf |= NS_LOSS | NS_LFN; + while (di && lfn[di - 1] != '.') di--; /* Find extension (di<=si: no extension) */ + + b = i = 0; ni = 8; + for (;;) { + w = lfn[si++]; /* Get an LFN char */ + if (!w) break; /* Break on end of the LFN */ + if (w == ' ' || (w == '.' && si != di)) { /* Remove spaces and dots */ + cf |= NS_LOSS | NS_LFN; continue; + } + + if (i >= ni || si == di) { /* Extension or end of SFN */ + if (ni == 11) { /* Long extension */ + cf |= NS_LOSS | NS_LFN; break; + } + if (si != di) cf |= NS_LOSS | NS_LFN; /* Out of 8.3 format */ + if (si > di) break; /* No extension */ + si = di; i = 8; ni = 11; /* Enter extension section */ + b <<= 2; continue; + } + + if (w >= 0x80) { /* Non ASCII char */ +#ifdef _EXCVT + w = ff_convert(w, 0); /* Unicode -> OEM code */ + if (w) w = excvt[w - 0x80]; /* Convert extended char to upper (SBCS) */ +#else + w = ff_convert(ff_wtoupper(w), 0); /* Upper converted Unicode -> OEM code */ +#endif + cf |= NS_LFN; /* Force create LFN entry */ + } + + if (_DF1S && w >= 0x100) { /* Double byte char (always false on SBCS cfg) */ + if (i >= ni - 1) { + cf |= NS_LOSS | NS_LFN; i = ni; continue; + } + dj->fn[i++] = (BYTE)(w >> 8); + } else { /* Single byte char */ + if (!w || chk_chr("+,;=[]", w)) { /* Replace illegal chars for SFN */ + w = '_'; cf |= NS_LOSS | NS_LFN;/* Lossy conversion */ + } else { + if (IsUpper(w)) { /* ASCII large capital */ + b |= 2; + } else { + if (IsLower(w)) { /* ASCII small capital */ + b |= 1; w -= 0x20; + } + } + } + } + dj->fn[i++] = (BYTE)w; + } + + if (dj->fn[0] == DDE) dj->fn[0] = NDDE; /* If the first char collides with deleted mark, replace it with 0x05 */ + + if (ni == 8) b <<= 2; + if ((b & 0x0C) == 0x0C || (b & 0x03) == 0x03) /* Create LFN entry when there are composite capitals */ + cf |= NS_LFN; + if (!(cf & NS_LFN)) { /* When LFN is in 8.3 format without extended char, NT flags are created */ + if ((b & 0x03) == 0x01) cf |= NS_EXT; /* NT flag (Extension has only small capital) */ + if ((b & 0x0C) == 0x04) cf |= NS_BODY; /* NT flag (Filename has only small capital) */ + } + + dj->fn[NS] = cf; /* SFN is created */ + + return FR_OK; + + +#else /* Non-LFN configuration */ + BYTE b, c, d, *sfn; + UINT ni, si, i; + const char *p; + + /* Create file name in directory form */ + for (p = *path; *p == '/' || *p == '\\'; p++) ; /* Strip duplicated separator */ + sfn = dj->fn; + mem_set(sfn, ' ', 11); + si = i = b = 0; ni = 8; +#if _FS_RPATH + if (p[si] == '.') { /* Is this a dot entry? */ + for (;;) { + c = (BYTE)p[si++]; + if (c != '.' || si >= 3) break; + sfn[i++] = c; + } + if (c != '/' && c != '\\' && c > ' ') return FR_INVALID_NAME; + *path = &p[si]; /* Return pointer to the next segment */ + sfn[NS] = (c <= ' ') ? NS_LAST | NS_DOT : NS_DOT; /* Set last segment flag if end of path */ + return FR_OK; + } +#endif + for (;;) { + c = (BYTE)p[si++]; + if (c <= ' ' || c == '/' || c == '\\') break; /* Break on end of segment */ + if (c == '.' || i >= ni) { + if (ni != 8 || c != '.') return FR_INVALID_NAME; + i = 8; ni = 11; + b <<= 2; continue; + } + if (c >= 0x80) { /* Extended char? */ + b |= 3; /* Eliminate NT flag */ +#ifdef _EXCVT + c = excvt[c - 0x80]; /* Upper conversion (SBCS) */ +#else +#if !_DF1S /* ASCII only cfg */ + return FR_INVALID_NAME; +#endif +#endif + } + if (IsDBCS1(c)) { /* Check if it is a DBC 1st byte (always false on SBCS cfg) */ + d = (BYTE)p[si++]; /* Get 2nd byte */ + if (!IsDBCS2(d) || i >= ni - 1) /* Reject invalid DBC */ + return FR_INVALID_NAME; + sfn[i++] = c; + sfn[i++] = d; + } else { /* Single byte code */ + if (chk_chr("\"*+,:;<=>\?[]|\x7F", c)) /* Reject illegal chrs for SFN */ + return FR_INVALID_NAME; + if (IsUpper(c)) { /* ASCII large capital? */ + b |= 2; + } else { + if (IsLower(c)) { /* ASCII small capital? */ + b |= 1; c -= 0x20; + } + } + sfn[i++] = c; + } + } + *path = &p[si]; /* Return pointer to the next segment */ + c = (c <= ' ') ? NS_LAST : 0; /* Set last segment flag if end of path */ + + if (!i) return FR_INVALID_NAME; /* Reject nul string */ + if (sfn[0] == DDE) sfn[0] = NDDE; /* When first char collides with DDE, replace it with 0x05 */ + + if (ni == 8) b <<= 2; + if ((b & 0x03) == 0x01) c |= NS_EXT; /* NT flag (Name extension has only small capital) */ + if ((b & 0x0C) == 0x04) c |= NS_BODY; /* NT flag (Name body has only small capital) */ + + sfn[NS] = c; /* Store NT flag, File name is created */ + + return FR_OK; +#endif +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Get file information from directory entry */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _FS_MINIMIZE <= 1 +static +void get_fileinfo ( /* No return code */ + DIR *dj, /* Pointer to the directory object */ + FILINFO *fno /* Pointer to the file information to be filled */ +) +{ + UINT i; + BYTE nt, *dir; + TCHAR *p, c; + + + p = fno->fname; + if (dj->sect) { + dir = dj->dir; + nt = dir[DIR_NTres]; /* NT flag */ + for (i = 0; i < 8; i++) { /* Copy name body */ + c = dir[i]; + if (c == ' ') break; + if (c == NDDE) c = (TCHAR)DDE; + if (_USE_LFN && (nt & NS_BODY) && IsUpper(c)) c += 0x20; +#if _LFN_UNICODE + if (IsDBCS1(c) && i < 7 && IsDBCS2(dir[i+1])) + c = (c << 8) | dir[++i]; + c = ff_convert(c, 1); + if (!c) c = '?'; +#endif + *p++ = c; + } + if (dir[8] != ' ') { /* Copy name extension */ + *p++ = '.'; + for (i = 8; i < 11; i++) { + c = dir[i]; + if (c == ' ') break; + if (_USE_LFN && (nt & NS_EXT) && IsUpper(c)) c += 0x20; +#if _LFN_UNICODE + if (IsDBCS1(c) && i < 10 && IsDBCS2(dir[i+1])) + c = (c << 8) | dir[++i]; + c = ff_convert(c, 1); + if (!c) c = '?'; +#endif + *p++ = c; + } + } + fno->fattrib = dir[DIR_Attr]; /* Attribute */ + fno->fsize = LD_DWORD(dir+DIR_FileSize); /* Size */ + fno->fdate = LD_WORD(dir+DIR_WrtDate); /* Date */ + fno->ftime = LD_WORD(dir+DIR_WrtTime); /* Time */ + } + *p = 0; /* Terminate SFN str by a \0 */ + +#if _USE_LFN + if (fno->lfname && fno->lfsize) { + TCHAR *tp = fno->lfname; + WCHAR w, *lfn; + + i = 0; + if (dj->sect && dj->lfn_idx != 0xFFFF) {/* Get LFN if available */ + lfn = dj->lfn; + while ((w = *lfn++) != 0) { /* Get an LFN char */ +#if !_LFN_UNICODE + w = ff_convert(w, 0); /* Unicode -> OEM conversion */ + if (!w) { i = 0; break; } /* Could not convert, no LFN */ + if (_DF1S && w >= 0x100) /* Put 1st byte if it is a DBC (always false on SBCS cfg) */ + tp[i++] = (TCHAR)(w >> 8); +#endif + if (i >= fno->lfsize - 1) { i = 0; break; } /* Buffer overflow, no LFN */ + tp[i++] = (TCHAR)w; + } + } + tp[i] = 0; /* Terminate the LFN str by a \0 */ + } +#endif +} +#endif /* _FS_MINIMIZE <= 1 */ + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Follow a file path */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT follow_path ( /* FR_OK(0): successful, !=0: error code */ + DIR *dj, /* Directory object to return last directory and found object */ + const TCHAR *path /* Full-path string to find a file or directory */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + BYTE *dir, ns; + + +#if _FS_RPATH + if (*path == '/' || *path == '\\') { /* There is a heading separator */ + path++; dj->sclust = 0; /* Strip it and start from the root dir */ + } else { /* No heading separator */ + dj->sclust = dj->fs->cdir; /* Start from the current dir */ + } +#else + if (*path == '/' || *path == '\\') /* Strip heading separator if exist */ + path++; + dj->sclust = 0; /* Start from the root dir */ +#endif + + if ((UINT)*path < ' ') { /* Nul path means the start directory itself */ + res = dir_sdi(dj, 0); + dj->dir = 0; + } else { /* Follow path */ + for (;;) { + res = create_name(dj, &path); /* Get a segment */ + if (res != FR_OK) break; + res = dir_find(dj); /* Find it */ + ns = *(dj->fn+NS); + if (res != FR_OK) { /* Failed to find the object */ + if (res != FR_NO_FILE) break; /* Abort if any hard error occurred */ + /* Object not found */ + if (_FS_RPATH && (ns & NS_DOT)) { /* If dot entry is not exit */ + dj->sclust = 0; dj->dir = 0; /* It is the root dir */ + res = FR_OK; + if (!(ns & NS_LAST)) continue; + } else { /* Could not find the object */ + if (!(ns & NS_LAST)) res = FR_NO_PATH; + } + break; + } + if (ns & NS_LAST) break; /* Last segment match. Function completed. */ + dir = dj->dir; /* There is next segment. Follow the sub directory */ + if (!(dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR)) { /* Cannot follow because it is a file */ + res = FR_NO_PATH; break; + } + dj->sclust = ld_clust(dj->fs, dir); + } + } + + return res; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Load a sector and check if it is an FAT Volume Boot Record */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +BYTE check_fs ( /* 0:FAT-VBR, 1:Any BR but not FAT, 2:Not a BR, 3:Disk error */ + FATFS *fs, /* File system object */ + DWORD sect /* Sector# (lba) to check if it is an FAT boot record or not */ +) +{ + if (disk_read(fs->drv, fs->win, sect, 1) != RES_OK) /* Load boot record */ + return 3; + if (LD_WORD(&fs->win[BS_55AA]) != 0xAA55) /* Check record signature (always placed at offset 510 even if the sector size is >512) */ + return 2; + + if ((LD_DWORD(&fs->win[BS_FilSysType]) & 0xFFFFFF) == 0x544146) /* Check "FAT" string */ + return 0; + if ((LD_DWORD(&fs->win[BS_FilSysType32]) & 0xFFFFFF) == 0x544146) + return 0; + + return 1; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Check if the file system object is valid or not */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT chk_mounted ( /* FR_OK(0): successful, !=0: any error occurred */ + const TCHAR **path, /* Pointer to pointer to the path name (drive number) */ + FATFS **rfs, /* Pointer to pointer to the found file system object */ + BYTE wmode /* !=0: Check write protection for write access */ +) +{ + BYTE fmt, b, pi, *tbl; + UINT vol; + DSTATUS stat; + DWORD bsect, fasize, tsect, sysect, nclst, szbfat; + WORD nrsv; + const TCHAR *p = *path; + FATFS *fs; + + + /* Get logical drive number from the path name */ + vol = p[0] - '0'; /* Is there a drive number? */ + if (vol <= 9 && p[1] == ':') { /* Found a drive number, get and strip it */ + p += 2; *path = p; /* Return pointer to the path name */ + } else { /* No drive number is given */ +#if _FS_RPATH + vol = CurrVol; /* Use current drive */ +#else + vol = 0; /* Use drive 0 */ +#endif + } + + /* Check if the file system object is valid or not */ + *rfs = 0; + if (vol >= _VOLUMES) /* Is the drive number valid? */ + return FR_INVALID_DRIVE; + fs = FatFs[vol]; /* Get corresponding file system object */ + if (!fs) return FR_NOT_ENABLED; /* Is the file system object available? */ + + ENTER_FF(fs); /* Lock file system */ + + *rfs = fs; /* Return pointer to the corresponding file system object */ + if (fs->fs_type) { /* If the volume has been mounted */ + stat = disk_status(fs->drv); + if (!(stat & STA_NOINIT)) { /* and the physical drive is kept initialized (has not been changed), */ + if (!_FS_READONLY && wmode && (stat & STA_PROTECT)) /* Check write protection if needed */ + return FR_WRITE_PROTECTED; + return FR_OK; /* The file system object is valid */ + } + } + + /* The file system object is not valid. */ + /* Following code attempts to mount the volume. (analyze BPB and initialize the fs object) */ + + fs->fs_type = 0; /* Clear the file system object */ + fs->drv = LD2PD(vol); /* Bind the logical drive and a physical drive */ + stat = disk_initialize(fs->drv); /* Initialize the physical drive */ + if (stat & STA_NOINIT) /* Check if the initialization succeeded */ + return FR_NOT_READY; /* Failed to initialize due to no medium or hard error */ + if (!_FS_READONLY && wmode && (stat & STA_PROTECT)) /* Check disk write protection if needed */ + return FR_WRITE_PROTECTED; +#if _MAX_SS != 512 /* Get disk sector size (variable sector size cfg only) */ + if (disk_ioctl(fs->drv, GET_SECTOR_SIZE, &fs->ssize) != RES_OK) + return FR_DISK_ERR; +#endif + /* Search FAT partition on the drive. Supports only generic partitions, FDISK and SFD. */ + fmt = check_fs(fs, bsect = 0); /* Load sector 0 and check if it is an FAT-VBR (in SFD) */ + if (LD2PT(vol) && !fmt) fmt = 1; /* Force non-SFD if the volume is forced partition */ + if (fmt == 1) { /* Not an FAT-VBR, the physical drive can be partitioned */ + /* Check the partition listed in the partition table */ + pi = LD2PT(vol); + if (pi) pi--; + tbl = &fs->win[MBR_Table + pi * SZ_PTE];/* Partition table */ + if (tbl[4]) { /* Is the partition existing? */ + bsect = LD_DWORD(&tbl[8]); /* Partition offset in LBA */ + fmt = check_fs(fs, bsect); /* Check the partition */ + } + } + if (fmt == 3) return FR_DISK_ERR; + if (fmt) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; /* No FAT volume is found */ + + /* An FAT volume is found. Following code initializes the file system object */ + + if (LD_WORD(fs->win+BPB_BytsPerSec) != SS(fs)) /* (BPB_BytsPerSec must be equal to the physical sector size) */ + return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; + + fasize = LD_WORD(fs->win+BPB_FATSz16); /* Number of sectors per FAT */ + if (!fasize) fasize = LD_DWORD(fs->win+BPB_FATSz32); + fs->fsize = fasize; + + fs->n_fats = b = fs->win[BPB_NumFATs]; /* Number of FAT copies */ + if (b != 1 && b != 2) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; /* (Must be 1 or 2) */ + fasize *= b; /* Number of sectors for FAT area */ + + fs->csize = b = fs->win[BPB_SecPerClus]; /* Number of sectors per cluster */ + if (!b || (b & (b - 1))) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; /* (Must be power of 2) */ + + fs->n_rootdir = LD_WORD(fs->win+BPB_RootEntCnt); /* Number of root directory entries */ + if (fs->n_rootdir % (SS(fs) / SZ_DIR)) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; /* (BPB_RootEntCnt must be sector aligned) */ + + tsect = LD_WORD(fs->win+BPB_TotSec16); /* Number of sectors on the volume */ + if (!tsect) tsect = LD_DWORD(fs->win+BPB_TotSec32); + + nrsv = LD_WORD(fs->win+BPB_RsvdSecCnt); /* Number of reserved sectors */ + if (!nrsv) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; /* (BPB_RsvdSecCnt must not be 0) */ + + /* Determine the FAT sub type */ + sysect = nrsv + fasize + fs->n_rootdir / (SS(fs) / SZ_DIR); /* RSV+FAT+DIR */ + if (tsect < sysect) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; /* (Invalid volume size) */ + nclst = (tsect - sysect) / fs->csize; /* Number of clusters */ + if (!nclst) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; /* (Invalid volume size) */ + fmt = FS_FAT12; + if (nclst >= MIN_FAT16) fmt = FS_FAT16; + if (nclst >= MIN_FAT32) fmt = FS_FAT32; + + /* Boundaries and Limits */ + fs->n_fatent = nclst + 2; /* Number of FAT entries */ + fs->database = bsect + sysect; /* Data start sector */ + fs->fatbase = bsect + nrsv; /* FAT start sector */ + if (fmt == FS_FAT32) { + if (fs->n_rootdir) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; /* (BPB_RootEntCnt must be 0) */ + fs->dirbase = LD_DWORD(fs->win+BPB_RootClus); /* Root directory start cluster */ + szbfat = fs->n_fatent * 4; /* (Required FAT size) */ + } else { + if (!fs->n_rootdir) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; /* (BPB_RootEntCnt must not be 0) */ + fs->dirbase = fs->fatbase + fasize; /* Root directory start sector */ + szbfat = (fmt == FS_FAT16) ? /* (Required FAT size) */ + fs->n_fatent * 2 : fs->n_fatent * 3 / 2 + (fs->n_fatent & 1); + } + if (fs->fsize < (szbfat + (SS(fs) - 1)) / SS(fs)) /* (BPB_FATSz must not be less than required) */ + return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; + +#if !_FS_READONLY + /* Initialize cluster allocation information */ + fs->free_clust = 0xFFFFFFFF; + fs->last_clust = 0; + + /* Get fsinfo if available */ + if (fmt == FS_FAT32) { + fs->fsi_flag = 0; + fs->fsi_sector = bsect + LD_WORD(fs->win+BPB_FSInfo); + if (disk_read(fs->drv, fs->win, fs->fsi_sector, 1) == RES_OK && + LD_WORD(fs->win+BS_55AA) == 0xAA55 && + LD_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_LeadSig) == 0x41615252 && + LD_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_StrucSig) == 0x61417272) { + fs->last_clust = LD_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_Nxt_Free); + fs->free_clust = LD_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_Free_Count); + } + } +#endif + fs->fs_type = fmt; /* FAT sub-type */ + fs->id = ++Fsid; /* File system mount ID */ + fs->winsect = 0; /* Invalidate sector cache */ + fs->wflag = 0; +#if _FS_RPATH + fs->cdir = 0; /* Current directory (root dir) */ +#endif +#if _FS_LOCK /* Clear file lock semaphores */ + clear_lock(fs); +#endif + + return FR_OK; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Check if the file/dir object is valid or not */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT validate ( /* FR_OK(0): The object is valid, !=0: Invalid */ + void* obj /* Pointer to the object FIL/DIR to check validity */ +) +{ + FIL *fil; + + + fil = (FIL*)obj; /* Assuming offset of fs and id in the FIL/DIR is identical */ + if (!fil->fs || !fil->fs->fs_type || fil->fs->id != fil->id) + return FR_INVALID_OBJECT; + + ENTER_FF(fil->fs); /* Lock file system */ + + if (disk_status(fil->fs->drv) & STA_NOINIT) + return FR_NOT_READY; + + return FR_OK; +} + + + + +/*-------------------------------------------------------------------------- + + Public Functions + +--------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Mount/Unmount a Logical Drive */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_mount ( + BYTE vol, /* Logical drive number to be mounted/unmounted */ + FATFS *fs /* Pointer to new file system object (NULL for unmount)*/ +) +{ + FATFS *rfs; + + + if (vol >= _VOLUMES) /* Check if the drive number is valid */ + return FR_INVALID_DRIVE; + rfs = FatFs[vol]; /* Get current fs object */ + + if (rfs) { +#if _FS_LOCK + clear_lock(rfs); +#endif +#if _FS_REENTRANT /* Discard sync object of the current volume */ + if (!ff_del_syncobj(rfs->sobj)) return FR_INT_ERR; +#endif + rfs->fs_type = 0; /* Clear old fs object */ + } + + if (fs) { + fs->fs_type = 0; /* Clear new fs object */ +#if _FS_REENTRANT /* Create sync object for the new volume */ + if (!ff_cre_syncobj(vol, &fs->sobj)) return FR_INT_ERR; +#endif + } + FatFs[vol] = fs; /* Register new fs object */ + + return FR_OK; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Open or Create a File */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_open ( + FIL *fp, /* Pointer to the blank file object */ + const TCHAR *path, /* Pointer to the file name */ + BYTE mode /* Access mode and file open mode flags */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DIR dj; + BYTE *dir; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + if (!fp) return FR_INVALID_OBJECT; + fp->fs = 0; /* Clear file object */ + +#if !_FS_READONLY + mode &= FA_READ | FA_WRITE | FA_CREATE_ALWAYS | FA_OPEN_ALWAYS | FA_CREATE_NEW; + res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, (BYTE)(mode & ~FA_READ)); +#else + mode &= FA_READ; + res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 0); +#endif + if (res == FR_OK) { + INIT_BUF(dj); + res = follow_path(&dj, path); /* Follow the file path */ + dir = dj.dir; +#if !_FS_READONLY /* R/W configuration */ + if (res == FR_OK) { + if (!dir) /* Current dir itself */ + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; +#if _FS_LOCK + else + res = chk_lock(&dj, (mode & ~FA_READ) ? 1 : 0); +#endif + } + /* Create or Open a file */ + if (mode & (FA_CREATE_ALWAYS | FA_OPEN_ALWAYS | FA_CREATE_NEW)) { + DWORD dw, cl; + + if (res != FR_OK) { /* No file, create new */ + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) /* There is no file to open, create a new entry */ +#if _FS_LOCK + res = enq_lock() ? dir_register(&dj) : FR_TOO_MANY_OPEN_FILES; +#else + res = dir_register(&dj); +#endif + mode |= FA_CREATE_ALWAYS; /* File is created */ + dir = dj.dir; /* New entry */ + } + else { /* Any object is already existing */ + if (dir[DIR_Attr] & (AM_RDO | AM_DIR)) { /* Cannot overwrite it (R/O or DIR) */ + res = FR_DENIED; + } else { + if (mode & FA_CREATE_NEW) /* Cannot create as new file */ + res = FR_EXIST; + } + } + if (res == FR_OK && (mode & FA_CREATE_ALWAYS)) { /* Truncate it if overwrite mode */ + dw = get_fattime(); /* Created time */ + ST_DWORD(dir+DIR_CrtTime, dw); + dir[DIR_Attr] = 0; /* Reset attribute */ + ST_DWORD(dir+DIR_FileSize, 0); /* size = 0 */ + cl = ld_clust(dj.fs, dir); /* Get start cluster */ + st_clust(dir, 0); /* cluster = 0 */ + dj.fs->wflag = 1; + if (cl) { /* Remove the cluster chain if exist */ + dw = dj.fs->winsect; + res = remove_chain(dj.fs, cl); + if (res == FR_OK) { + dj.fs->last_clust = cl - 1; /* Reuse the cluster hole */ + res = move_window(dj.fs, dw); + } + } + } + } + else { /* Open an existing file */ + if (res == FR_OK) { /* Follow succeeded */ + if (dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR) { /* It is a directory */ + res = FR_NO_FILE; + } else { + if ((mode & FA_WRITE) && (dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_RDO)) /* R/O violation */ + res = FR_DENIED; + } + } + } + if (res == FR_OK) { + if (mode & FA_CREATE_ALWAYS) /* Set file change flag if created or overwritten */ + mode |= FA__WRITTEN; + fp->dir_sect = dj.fs->winsect; /* Pointer to the directory entry */ + fp->dir_ptr = dir; +#if _FS_LOCK + fp->lockid = inc_lock(&dj, (mode & ~FA_READ) ? 1 : 0); + if (!fp->lockid) res = FR_INT_ERR; +#endif + } + +#else /* R/O configuration */ + if (res == FR_OK) { /* Follow succeeded */ + dir = dj.dir; + if (!dir) { /* Current dir itself */ + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; + } else { + if (dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR) /* It is a directory */ + res = FR_NO_FILE; + } + } +#endif + FREE_BUF(); + + if (res == FR_OK) { + fp->flag = mode; /* File access mode */ + fp->sclust = ld_clust(dj.fs, dir); /* File start cluster */ + fp->fsize = LD_DWORD(dir+DIR_FileSize); /* File size */ + fp->fptr = 0; /* File pointer */ + fp->dsect = 0; +#if _USE_FASTSEEK + fp->cltbl = 0; /* Normal seek mode */ +#endif + fp->fs = dj.fs; fp->id = dj.fs->id; /* Validate file object */ + } + } + + LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Read File */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_read ( + FIL *fp, /* Pointer to the file object */ + void *buff, /* Pointer to data buffer */ + UINT btr, /* Number of bytes to read */ + UINT *br /* Pointer to number of bytes read */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DWORD clst, sect, remain; + UINT rcnt, cc; + BYTE csect, *rbuff = buff; + + + *br = 0; /* Clear read byte counter */ + + res = validate(fp); /* Check validity */ + if (res != FR_OK) LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); + if (fp->flag & FA__ERROR) /* Aborted file? */ + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + if (!(fp->flag & FA_READ)) /* Check access mode */ + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_DENIED); + remain = fp->fsize - fp->fptr; + if (btr > remain) btr = (UINT)remain; /* Truncate btr by remaining bytes */ + + for ( ; btr; /* Repeat until all data read */ + rbuff += rcnt, fp->fptr += rcnt, *br += rcnt, btr -= rcnt) { + if ((fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)) == 0) { /* On the sector boundary? */ + csect = (BYTE)(fp->fptr / SS(fp->fs) & (fp->fs->csize - 1)); /* Sector offset in the cluster */ + if (!csect) { /* On the cluster boundary? */ + if (fp->fptr == 0) { /* On the top of the file? */ + clst = fp->sclust; /* Follow from the origin */ + } else { /* Middle or end of the file */ +#if _USE_FASTSEEK + if (fp->cltbl) + clst = clmt_clust(fp, fp->fptr); /* Get cluster# from the CLMT */ + else +#endif + clst = get_fat(fp->fs, fp->clust); /* Follow cluster chain on the FAT */ + } + if (clst < 2) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->clust = clst; /* Update current cluster */ + } + sect = clust2sect(fp->fs, fp->clust); /* Get current sector */ + if (!sect) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + sect += csect; + cc = btr / SS(fp->fs); /* When remaining bytes >= sector size, */ + if (cc) { /* Read maximum contiguous sectors directly */ + if (csect + cc > fp->fs->csize) /* Clip at cluster boundary */ + cc = fp->fs->csize - csect; + if (disk_read(fp->fs->drv, rbuff, sect, (BYTE)cc) != RES_OK) + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +#if !_FS_READONLY && _FS_MINIMIZE <= 2 /* Replace one of the read sectors with cached data if it contains a dirty sector */ +#if _FS_TINY + if (fp->fs->wflag && fp->fs->winsect - sect < cc) + mem_cpy(rbuff + ((fp->fs->winsect - sect) * SS(fp->fs)), fp->fs->win, SS(fp->fs)); +#else + if ((fp->flag & FA__DIRTY) && fp->dsect - sect < cc) + mem_cpy(rbuff + ((fp->dsect - sect) * SS(fp->fs)), fp->buf, SS(fp->fs)); +#endif +#endif + rcnt = SS(fp->fs) * cc; /* Number of bytes transferred */ + continue; + } +#if !_FS_TINY + if (fp->dsect != sect) { /* Load data sector if not in cache */ +#if !_FS_READONLY + if (fp->flag & FA__DIRTY) { /* Write-back dirty sector cache */ + if (disk_write(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, fp->dsect, 1) != RES_OK) + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->flag &= ~FA__DIRTY; + } +#endif + if (disk_read(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, sect, 1) != RES_OK) /* Fill sector cache */ + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + } +#endif + fp->dsect = sect; + } + rcnt = SS(fp->fs) - ((UINT)fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)); /* Get partial sector data from sector buffer */ + if (rcnt > btr) rcnt = btr; +#if _FS_TINY + if (move_window(fp->fs, fp->dsect)) /* Move sector window */ + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + mem_cpy(rbuff, &fp->fs->win[fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)], rcnt); /* Pick partial sector */ +#else + mem_cpy(rbuff, &fp->buf[fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)], rcnt); /* Pick partial sector */ +#endif + } + + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_OK); +} + + + + +#if !_FS_READONLY +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Write File */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_write ( + FIL *fp, /* Pointer to the file object */ + const void *buff, /* Pointer to the data to be written */ + UINT btw, /* Number of bytes to write */ + UINT *bw /* Pointer to number of bytes written */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DWORD clst, sect; + UINT wcnt, cc; + const BYTE *wbuff = buff; + BYTE csect; + + + *bw = 0; /* Clear write byte counter */ + + res = validate(fp); /* Check validity */ + if (res != FR_OK) LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); + if (fp->flag & FA__ERROR) /* Aborted file? */ + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + if (!(fp->flag & FA_WRITE)) /* Check access mode */ + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_DENIED); + if ((DWORD)(fp->fsize + btw) < fp->fsize) btw = 0; /* File size cannot reach 4GB */ + + for ( ; btw; /* Repeat until all data written */ + wbuff += wcnt, fp->fptr += wcnt, *bw += wcnt, btw -= wcnt) { + if ((fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)) == 0) { /* On the sector boundary? */ + csect = (BYTE)(fp->fptr / SS(fp->fs) & (fp->fs->csize - 1)); /* Sector offset in the cluster */ + if (!csect) { /* On the cluster boundary? */ + if (fp->fptr == 0) { /* On the top of the file? */ + clst = fp->sclust; /* Follow from the origin */ + if (clst == 0) /* When no cluster is allocated, */ + fp->sclust = clst = create_chain(fp->fs, 0); /* Create a new cluster chain */ + } else { /* Middle or end of the file */ +#if _USE_FASTSEEK + if (fp->cltbl) + clst = clmt_clust(fp, fp->fptr); /* Get cluster# from the CLMT */ + else +#endif + clst = create_chain(fp->fs, fp->clust); /* Follow or stretch cluster chain on the FAT */ + } + if (clst == 0) break; /* Could not allocate a new cluster (disk full) */ + if (clst == 1) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->clust = clst; /* Update current cluster */ + } +#if _FS_TINY + if (fp->fs->winsect == fp->dsect && move_window(fp->fs, 0)) /* Write-back sector cache */ + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +#else + if (fp->flag & FA__DIRTY) { /* Write-back sector cache */ + if (disk_write(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, fp->dsect, 1) != RES_OK) + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->flag &= ~FA__DIRTY; + } +#endif + sect = clust2sect(fp->fs, fp->clust); /* Get current sector */ + if (!sect) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + sect += csect; + cc = btw / SS(fp->fs); /* When remaining bytes >= sector size, */ + if (cc) { /* Write maximum contiguous sectors directly */ + if (csect + cc > fp->fs->csize) /* Clip at cluster boundary */ + cc = fp->fs->csize - csect; + if (disk_write(fp->fs->drv, wbuff, sect, (BYTE)cc) != RES_OK) + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +#if _FS_TINY + if (fp->fs->winsect - sect < cc) { /* Refill sector cache if it gets invalidated by the direct write */ + mem_cpy(fp->fs->win, wbuff + ((fp->fs->winsect - sect) * SS(fp->fs)), SS(fp->fs)); + fp->fs->wflag = 0; + } +#else + if (fp->dsect - sect < cc) { /* Refill sector cache if it gets invalidated by the direct write */ + mem_cpy(fp->buf, wbuff + ((fp->dsect - sect) * SS(fp->fs)), SS(fp->fs)); + fp->flag &= ~FA__DIRTY; + } +#endif + wcnt = SS(fp->fs) * cc; /* Number of bytes transferred */ + continue; + } +#if _FS_TINY + if (fp->fptr >= fp->fsize) { /* Avoid silly cache filling at growing edge */ + if (move_window(fp->fs, 0)) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->fs->winsect = sect; + } +#else + if (fp->dsect != sect) { /* Fill sector cache with file data */ + if (fp->fptr < fp->fsize && + disk_read(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, sect, 1) != RES_OK) + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + } +#endif + fp->dsect = sect; + } + wcnt = SS(fp->fs) - ((UINT)fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs));/* Put partial sector into file I/O buffer */ + if (wcnt > btw) wcnt = btw; +#if _FS_TINY + if (move_window(fp->fs, fp->dsect)) /* Move sector window */ + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + mem_cpy(&fp->fs->win[fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)], wbuff, wcnt); /* Fit partial sector */ + fp->fs->wflag = 1; +#else + mem_cpy(&fp->buf[fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)], wbuff, wcnt); /* Fit partial sector */ + fp->flag |= FA__DIRTY; +#endif + } + + if (fp->fptr > fp->fsize) fp->fsize = fp->fptr; /* Update file size if needed */ + fp->flag |= FA__WRITTEN; /* Set file change flag */ + + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_OK); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Synchronize the File Object */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_sync ( + FIL *fp /* Pointer to the file object */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DWORD tim; + BYTE *dir; + + + res = validate(fp); /* Check validity of the object */ + if (res == FR_OK) { + if (fp->flag & FA__WRITTEN) { /* Has the file been written? */ +#if !_FS_TINY /* Write-back dirty buffer */ + if (fp->flag & FA__DIRTY) { + if (disk_write(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, fp->dsect, 1) != RES_OK) + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->flag &= ~FA__DIRTY; + } +#endif + /* Update the directory entry */ + res = move_window(fp->fs, fp->dir_sect); + if (res == FR_OK) { + dir = fp->dir_ptr; + dir[DIR_Attr] |= AM_ARC; /* Set archive bit */ + ST_DWORD(dir+DIR_FileSize, fp->fsize); /* Update file size */ + st_clust(dir, fp->sclust); /* Update start cluster */ + tim = get_fattime(); /* Update updated time */ + ST_DWORD(dir+DIR_WrtTime, tim); + ST_WORD(dir+DIR_LstAccDate, 0); + fp->flag &= ~FA__WRITTEN; + fp->fs->wflag = 1; + res = sync(fp->fs); + } + } + } + + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); +} + +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Close File */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_close ( + FIL *fp /* Pointer to the file object to be closed */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + + +#if _FS_READONLY + res = validate(fp); + { +#if _FS_REENTRANT + FATFS *fs = fp->fs; +#endif + if (res == FR_OK) fp->fs = 0; /* Discard file object */ + LEAVE_FF(fs, res); + } +#else + res = f_sync(fp); /* Flush cached data */ +#if _FS_LOCK + if (res == FR_OK) { /* Decrement open counter */ +#if _FS_REENTRANT + FATFS *fs = fp->fs;; + res = validate(fp); + if (res == FR_OK) { + res = dec_lock(fp->lockid); + unlock_fs(fs, FR_OK); + } +#else + res = dec_lock(fp->lockid); +#endif + } +#endif + if (res == FR_OK) fp->fs = 0; /* Discard file object */ + return res; +#endif +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Current Drive/Directory Handlings */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#if _FS_RPATH >= 1 + +FRESULT f_chdrive ( + BYTE drv /* Drive number */ +) +{ + if (drv >= _VOLUMES) return FR_INVALID_DRIVE; + + CurrVol = drv; + + return FR_OK; +} + + + +FRESULT f_chdir ( + const TCHAR *path /* Pointer to the directory path */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DIR dj; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 0); + if (res == FR_OK) { + INIT_BUF(dj); + res = follow_path(&dj, path); /* Follow the path */ + FREE_BUF(); + if (res == FR_OK) { /* Follow completed */ + if (!dj.dir) { + dj.fs->cdir = dj.sclust; /* Start directory itself */ + } else { + if (dj.dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR) /* Reached to the directory */ + dj.fs->cdir = ld_clust(dj.fs, dj.dir); + else + res = FR_NO_PATH; /* Reached but a file */ + } + } + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) res = FR_NO_PATH; + } + + LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + +#if _FS_RPATH >= 2 +FRESULT f_getcwd ( + TCHAR *path, /* Pointer to the directory path */ + UINT sz_path /* Size of path */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DIR dj; + UINT i, n; + DWORD ccl; + TCHAR *tp; + FILINFO fno; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + *path = 0; + res = chk_mounted((const TCHAR**)&path, &dj.fs, 0); /* Get current volume */ + if (res == FR_OK) { + INIT_BUF(dj); + i = sz_path; /* Bottom of buffer (dir stack base) */ + dj.sclust = dj.fs->cdir; /* Start to follow upper dir from current dir */ + while ((ccl = dj.sclust) != 0) { /* Repeat while current dir is a sub-dir */ + res = dir_sdi(&dj, 1); /* Get parent dir */ + if (res != FR_OK) break; + res = dir_read(&dj); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + dj.sclust = ld_clust(dj.fs, dj.dir); /* Goto parent dir */ + res = dir_sdi(&dj, 0); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + do { /* Find the entry links to the child dir */ + res = dir_read(&dj); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + if (ccl == ld_clust(dj.fs, dj.dir)) break; /* Found the entry */ + res = dir_next(&dj, 0); + } while (res == FR_OK); + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) res = FR_INT_ERR;/* It cannot be 'not found'. */ + if (res != FR_OK) break; +#if _USE_LFN + fno.lfname = path; + fno.lfsize = i; +#endif + get_fileinfo(&dj, &fno); /* Get the dir name and push it to the buffer */ + tp = fno.fname; + if (_USE_LFN && *path) tp = path; + for (n = 0; tp[n]; n++) ; + if (i < n + 3) { + res = FR_NOT_ENOUGH_CORE; break; + } + while (n) path[--i] = tp[--n]; + path[--i] = '/'; + } + tp = path; + if (res == FR_OK) { + *tp++ = '0' + CurrVol; /* Put drive number */ + *tp++ = ':'; + if (i == sz_path) { /* Root-dir */ + *tp++ = '/'; + } else { /* Sub-dir */ + do /* Add stacked path str */ + *tp++ = path[i++]; + while (i < sz_path); + } + } + *tp = 0; + FREE_BUF(); + } + + LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} +#endif /* _FS_RPATH >= 2 */ +#endif /* _FS_RPATH >= 1 */ + + + +#if _FS_MINIMIZE <= 2 +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Seek File R/W Pointer */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_lseek ( + FIL *fp, /* Pointer to the file object */ + DWORD ofs /* File pointer from top of file */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + + + res = validate(fp); /* Check validity of the object */ + if (res != FR_OK) LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); + if (fp->flag & FA__ERROR) /* Check abort flag */ + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + +#if _USE_FASTSEEK + if (fp->cltbl) { /* Fast seek */ + DWORD cl, pcl, ncl, tcl, dsc, tlen, ulen, *tbl; + + if (ofs == CREATE_LINKMAP) { /* Create CLMT */ + tbl = fp->cltbl; + tlen = *tbl++; ulen = 2; /* Given table size and required table size */ + cl = fp->sclust; /* Top of the chain */ + if (cl) { + do { + /* Get a fragment */ + tcl = cl; ncl = 0; ulen += 2; /* Top, length and used items */ + do { + pcl = cl; ncl++; + cl = get_fat(fp->fs, cl); + if (cl <= 1) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + if (cl == 0xFFFFFFFF) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + } while (cl == pcl + 1); + if (ulen <= tlen) { /* Store the length and top of the fragment */ + *tbl++ = ncl; *tbl++ = tcl; + } + } while (cl < fp->fs->n_fatent); /* Repeat until end of chain */ + } + *fp->cltbl = ulen; /* Number of items used */ + if (ulen <= tlen) + *tbl = 0; /* Terminate table */ + else + res = FR_NOT_ENOUGH_CORE; /* Given table size is smaller than required */ + + } else { /* Fast seek */ + if (ofs > fp->fsize) /* Clip offset at the file size */ + ofs = fp->fsize; + fp->fptr = ofs; /* Set file pointer */ + if (ofs) { + fp->clust = clmt_clust(fp, ofs - 1); + dsc = clust2sect(fp->fs, fp->clust); + if (!dsc) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + dsc += (ofs - 1) / SS(fp->fs) & (fp->fs->csize - 1); + if (fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs) && dsc != fp->dsect) { /* Refill sector cache if needed */ +#if !_FS_TINY +#if !_FS_READONLY + if (fp->flag & FA__DIRTY) { /* Write-back dirty sector cache */ + if (disk_write(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, fp->dsect, 1) != RES_OK) + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->flag &= ~FA__DIRTY; + } +#endif + if (disk_read(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, dsc, 1) != RES_OK) /* Load current sector */ + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +#endif + fp->dsect = dsc; + } + } + } + } else +#endif + + /* Normal Seek */ + { + DWORD clst, bcs, nsect, ifptr; + + if (ofs > fp->fsize /* In read-only mode, clip offset with the file size */ +#if !_FS_READONLY + && !(fp->flag & FA_WRITE) +#endif + ) ofs = fp->fsize; + + ifptr = fp->fptr; + fp->fptr = nsect = 0; + if (ofs) { + bcs = (DWORD)fp->fs->csize * SS(fp->fs); /* Cluster size (byte) */ + if (ifptr > 0 && + (ofs - 1) / bcs >= (ifptr - 1) / bcs) { /* When seek to same or following cluster, */ + fp->fptr = (ifptr - 1) & ~(bcs - 1); /* start from the current cluster */ + ofs -= fp->fptr; + clst = fp->clust; + } else { /* When seek to back cluster, */ + clst = fp->sclust; /* start from the first cluster */ +#if !_FS_READONLY + if (clst == 0) { /* If no cluster chain, create a new chain */ + clst = create_chain(fp->fs, 0); + if (clst == 1) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->sclust = clst; + } +#endif + fp->clust = clst; + } + if (clst != 0) { + while (ofs > bcs) { /* Cluster following loop */ +#if !_FS_READONLY + if (fp->flag & FA_WRITE) { /* Check if in write mode or not */ + clst = create_chain(fp->fs, clst); /* Force stretch if in write mode */ + if (clst == 0) { /* When disk gets full, clip file size */ + ofs = bcs; break; + } + } else +#endif + clst = get_fat(fp->fs, clst); /* Follow cluster chain if not in write mode */ + if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + if (clst <= 1 || clst >= fp->fs->n_fatent) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + fp->clust = clst; + fp->fptr += bcs; + ofs -= bcs; + } + fp->fptr += ofs; + if (ofs % SS(fp->fs)) { + nsect = clust2sect(fp->fs, clst); /* Current sector */ + if (!nsect) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + nsect += ofs / SS(fp->fs); + } + } + } + if (fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs) && nsect != fp->dsect) { /* Fill sector cache if needed */ +#if !_FS_TINY +#if !_FS_READONLY + if (fp->flag & FA__DIRTY) { /* Write-back dirty sector cache */ + if (disk_write(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, fp->dsect, 1) != RES_OK) + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->flag &= ~FA__DIRTY; + } +#endif + if (disk_read(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, nsect, 1) != RES_OK) /* Fill sector cache */ + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +#endif + fp->dsect = nsect; + } +#if !_FS_READONLY + if (fp->fptr > fp->fsize) { /* Set file change flag if the file size is extended */ + fp->fsize = fp->fptr; + fp->flag |= FA__WRITTEN; + } +#endif + } + + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); +} + + + +#if _FS_MINIMIZE <= 1 +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Create a Directory Object */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_opendir ( + DIR *dj, /* Pointer to directory object to create */ + const TCHAR *path /* Pointer to the directory path */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + FATFS *fs; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + if (!dj) return FR_INVALID_OBJECT; + + res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj->fs, 0); + fs = dj->fs; + if (res == FR_OK) { + INIT_BUF(*dj); + res = follow_path(dj, path); /* Follow the path to the directory */ + FREE_BUF(); + if (res == FR_OK) { /* Follow completed */ + if (dj->dir) { /* It is not the root dir */ + if (dj->dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR) { /* The object is a directory */ + dj->sclust = ld_clust(fs, dj->dir); + } else { /* The object is not a directory */ + res = FR_NO_PATH; + } + } + if (res == FR_OK) { + dj->id = fs->id; + res = dir_sdi(dj, 0); /* Rewind dir */ + } + } + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) res = FR_NO_PATH; + if (res != FR_OK) dj->fs = 0; /* Invalidate the dir object if function faild */ + } else { + dj->fs = 0; + } + + LEAVE_FF(fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Read Directory Entry in Sequence */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_readdir ( + DIR *dj, /* Pointer to the open directory object */ + FILINFO *fno /* Pointer to file information to return */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + res = validate(dj); /* Check validity of the object */ + if (res == FR_OK) { + if (!fno) { + res = dir_sdi(dj, 0); /* Rewind the directory object */ + } else { + INIT_BUF(*dj); + res = dir_read(dj); /* Read an directory item */ + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) { /* Reached end of dir */ + dj->sect = 0; + res = FR_OK; + } + if (res == FR_OK) { /* A valid entry is found */ + get_fileinfo(dj, fno); /* Get the object information */ + res = dir_next(dj, 0); /* Increment index for next */ + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) { + dj->sect = 0; + res = FR_OK; + } + } + FREE_BUF(); + } + } + + LEAVE_FF(dj->fs, res); +} + + + +#if _FS_MINIMIZE == 0 +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Get File Status */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_stat ( + const TCHAR *path, /* Pointer to the file path */ + FILINFO *fno /* Pointer to file information to return */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DIR dj; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 0); + if (res == FR_OK) { + INIT_BUF(dj); + res = follow_path(&dj, path); /* Follow the file path */ + if (res == FR_OK) { /* Follow completed */ + if (dj.dir) /* Found an object */ + get_fileinfo(&dj, fno); + else /* It is root dir */ + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; + } + FREE_BUF(); + } + + LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + + +#if !_FS_READONLY +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Get Number of Free Clusters */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_getfree ( + const TCHAR *path, /* Pointer to the logical drive number (root dir) */ + DWORD *nclst, /* Pointer to the variable to return number of free clusters */ + FATFS **fatfs /* Pointer to pointer to corresponding file system object to return */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + FATFS *fs; + DWORD n, clst, sect, stat; + UINT i; + BYTE fat, *p; + + + /* Get drive number */ + res = chk_mounted(&path, fatfs, 0); + fs = *fatfs; + if (res == FR_OK) { + /* If free_clust is valid, return it without full cluster scan */ + if (fs->free_clust <= fs->n_fatent - 2) { + *nclst = fs->free_clust; + } else { + /* Get number of free clusters */ + fat = fs->fs_type; + n = 0; + if (fat == FS_FAT12) { + clst = 2; + do { + stat = get_fat(fs, clst); + if (stat == 0xFFFFFFFF) { res = FR_DISK_ERR; break; } + if (stat == 1) { res = FR_INT_ERR; break; } + if (stat == 0) n++; + } while (++clst < fs->n_fatent); + } else { + clst = fs->n_fatent; + sect = fs->fatbase; + i = 0; p = 0; + do { + if (!i) { + res = move_window(fs, sect++); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + p = fs->win; + i = SS(fs); + } + if (fat == FS_FAT16) { + if (LD_WORD(p) == 0) n++; + p += 2; i -= 2; + } else { + if ((LD_DWORD(p) & 0x0FFFFFFF) == 0) n++; + p += 4; i -= 4; + } + } while (--clst); + } + fs->free_clust = n; + if (fat == FS_FAT32) fs->fsi_flag = 1; + *nclst = n; + } + } + LEAVE_FF(fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Truncate File */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_truncate ( + FIL *fp /* Pointer to the file object */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DWORD ncl; + + + if (!fp) return FR_INVALID_OBJECT; + + res = validate(fp); /* Check validity of the object */ + if (res == FR_OK) { + if (fp->flag & FA__ERROR) { /* Check abort flag */ + res = FR_INT_ERR; + } else { + if (!(fp->flag & FA_WRITE)) /* Check access mode */ + res = FR_DENIED; + } + } + if (res == FR_OK) { + if (fp->fsize > fp->fptr) { + fp->fsize = fp->fptr; /* Set file size to current R/W point */ + fp->flag |= FA__WRITTEN; + if (fp->fptr == 0) { /* When set file size to zero, remove entire cluster chain */ + res = remove_chain(fp->fs, fp->sclust); + fp->sclust = 0; + } else { /* When truncate a part of the file, remove remaining clusters */ + ncl = get_fat(fp->fs, fp->clust); + res = FR_OK; + if (ncl == 0xFFFFFFFF) res = FR_DISK_ERR; + if (ncl == 1) res = FR_INT_ERR; + if (res == FR_OK && ncl < fp->fs->n_fatent) { + res = put_fat(fp->fs, fp->clust, 0x0FFFFFFF); + if (res == FR_OK) res = remove_chain(fp->fs, ncl); + } + } + } + if (res != FR_OK) fp->flag |= FA__ERROR; + } + + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Delete a File or Directory */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_unlink ( + const TCHAR *path /* Pointer to the file or directory path */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DIR dj, sdj; + BYTE *dir; + DWORD dclst; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 1); + if (res == FR_OK) { + INIT_BUF(dj); + res = follow_path(&dj, path); /* Follow the file path */ + if (_FS_RPATH && res == FR_OK && (dj.fn[NS] & NS_DOT)) + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; /* Cannot remove dot entry */ +#if _FS_LOCK + if (res == FR_OK) res = chk_lock(&dj, 2); /* Cannot remove open file */ +#endif + if (res == FR_OK) { /* The object is accessible */ + dir = dj.dir; + if (!dir) { + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; /* Cannot remove the start directory */ + } else { + if (dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_RDO) + res = FR_DENIED; /* Cannot remove R/O object */ + } + dclst = ld_clust(dj.fs, dir); + if (res == FR_OK && (dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR)) { /* Is it a sub-dir? */ + if (dclst < 2) { + res = FR_INT_ERR; + } else { + mem_cpy(&sdj, &dj, sizeof (DIR)); /* Check if the sub-dir is empty or not */ + sdj.sclust = dclst; + res = dir_sdi(&sdj, 2); /* Exclude dot entries */ + if (res == FR_OK) { + res = dir_read(&sdj); + if (res == FR_OK /* Not empty dir */ +#if _FS_RPATH + || dclst == dj.fs->cdir /* Current dir */ +#endif + ) res = FR_DENIED; + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) res = FR_OK; /* Empty */ + } + } + } + if (res == FR_OK) { + res = dir_remove(&dj); /* Remove the directory entry */ + if (res == FR_OK) { + if (dclst) /* Remove the cluster chain if exist */ + res = remove_chain(dj.fs, dclst); + if (res == FR_OK) res = sync(dj.fs); + } + } + } + FREE_BUF(); + } + LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Create a Directory */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_mkdir ( + const TCHAR *path /* Pointer to the directory path */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DIR dj; + BYTE *dir, n; + DWORD dsc, dcl, pcl, tim = get_fattime(); + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 1); + if (res == FR_OK) { + INIT_BUF(dj); + res = follow_path(&dj, path); /* Follow the file path */ + if (res == FR_OK) res = FR_EXIST; /* Any object with same name is already existing */ + if (_FS_RPATH && res == FR_NO_FILE && (dj.fn[NS] & NS_DOT)) + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) { /* Can create a new directory */ + dcl = create_chain(dj.fs, 0); /* Allocate a cluster for the new directory table */ + res = FR_OK; + if (dcl == 0) res = FR_DENIED; /* No space to allocate a new cluster */ + if (dcl == 1) res = FR_INT_ERR; + if (dcl == 0xFFFFFFFF) res = FR_DISK_ERR; + if (res == FR_OK) /* Flush FAT */ + res = move_window(dj.fs, 0); + if (res == FR_OK) { /* Initialize the new directory table */ + dsc = clust2sect(dj.fs, dcl); + dir = dj.fs->win; + mem_set(dir, 0, SS(dj.fs)); + mem_set(dir+DIR_Name, ' ', 8+3); /* Create "." entry */ + dir[DIR_Name] = '.'; + dir[DIR_Attr] = AM_DIR; + ST_DWORD(dir+DIR_WrtTime, tim); + st_clust(dir, dcl); + mem_cpy(dir+SZ_DIR, dir, SZ_DIR); /* Create ".." entry */ + dir[33] = '.'; pcl = dj.sclust; + if (dj.fs->fs_type == FS_FAT32 && pcl == dj.fs->dirbase) + pcl = 0; + st_clust(dir+SZ_DIR, pcl); + for (n = dj.fs->csize; n; n--) { /* Write dot entries and clear following sectors */ + dj.fs->winsect = dsc++; + dj.fs->wflag = 1; + res = move_window(dj.fs, 0); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + mem_set(dir, 0, SS(dj.fs)); + } + } + if (res == FR_OK) res = dir_register(&dj); /* Register the object to the directoy */ + if (res != FR_OK) { + remove_chain(dj.fs, dcl); /* Could not register, remove cluster chain */ + } else { + dir = dj.dir; + dir[DIR_Attr] = AM_DIR; /* Attribute */ + ST_DWORD(dir+DIR_WrtTime, tim); /* Created time */ + st_clust(dir, dcl); /* Table start cluster */ + dj.fs->wflag = 1; + res = sync(dj.fs); + } + } + FREE_BUF(); + } + + LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Change Attribute */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_chmod ( + const TCHAR *path, /* Pointer to the file path */ + BYTE value, /* Attribute bits */ + BYTE mask /* Attribute mask to change */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DIR dj; + BYTE *dir; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 1); + if (res == FR_OK) { + INIT_BUF(dj); + res = follow_path(&dj, path); /* Follow the file path */ + FREE_BUF(); + if (_FS_RPATH && res == FR_OK && (dj.fn[NS] & NS_DOT)) + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; + if (res == FR_OK) { + dir = dj.dir; + if (!dir) { /* Is it a root directory? */ + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; + } else { /* File or sub directory */ + mask &= AM_RDO|AM_HID|AM_SYS|AM_ARC; /* Valid attribute mask */ + dir[DIR_Attr] = (value & mask) | (dir[DIR_Attr] & (BYTE)~mask); /* Apply attribute change */ + dj.fs->wflag = 1; + res = sync(dj.fs); + } + } + } + + LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Change Timestamp */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_utime ( + const TCHAR *path, /* Pointer to the file/directory name */ + const FILINFO *fno /* Pointer to the time stamp to be set */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DIR dj; + BYTE *dir; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 1); + if (res == FR_OK) { + INIT_BUF(dj); + res = follow_path(&dj, path); /* Follow the file path */ + FREE_BUF(); + if (_FS_RPATH && res == FR_OK && (dj.fn[NS] & NS_DOT)) + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; + if (res == FR_OK) { + dir = dj.dir; + if (!dir) { /* Root directory */ + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; + } else { /* File or sub-directory */ + ST_WORD(dir+DIR_WrtTime, fno->ftime); + ST_WORD(dir+DIR_WrtDate, fno->fdate); + dj.fs->wflag = 1; + res = sync(dj.fs); + } + } + } + + LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Rename File/Directory */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_rename ( + const TCHAR *path_old, /* Pointer to the old name */ + const TCHAR *path_new /* Pointer to the new name */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DIR djo, djn; + BYTE buf[21], *dir; + DWORD dw; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + res = chk_mounted(&path_old, &djo.fs, 1); + if (res == FR_OK) { + djn.fs = djo.fs; + INIT_BUF(djo); + res = follow_path(&djo, path_old); /* Check old object */ + if (_FS_RPATH && res == FR_OK && (djo.fn[NS] & NS_DOT)) + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; +#if _FS_LOCK + if (res == FR_OK) res = chk_lock(&djo, 2); +#endif + if (res == FR_OK) { /* Old object is found */ + if (!djo.dir) { /* Is root dir? */ + res = FR_NO_FILE; + } else { + mem_cpy(buf, djo.dir+DIR_Attr, 21); /* Save the object information except for name */ + mem_cpy(&djn, &djo, sizeof (DIR)); /* Check new object */ + res = follow_path(&djn, path_new); + if (res == FR_OK) res = FR_EXIST; /* The new object name is already existing */ + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) { /* Is it a valid path and no name collision? */ +/* Start critical section that an interruption or error can cause cross-link */ + res = dir_register(&djn); /* Register the new entry */ + if (res == FR_OK) { + dir = djn.dir; /* Copy object information except for name */ + mem_cpy(dir+13, buf+2, 19); + dir[DIR_Attr] = buf[0] | AM_ARC; + djo.fs->wflag = 1; + if (djo.sclust != djn.sclust && (dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR)) { /* Update .. entry in the directory if needed */ + dw = clust2sect(djo.fs, ld_clust(djo.fs, dir)); + if (!dw) { + res = FR_INT_ERR; + } else { + res = move_window(djo.fs, dw); + dir = djo.fs->win+SZ_DIR; /* .. entry */ + if (res == FR_OK && dir[1] == '.') { + dw = (djo.fs->fs_type == FS_FAT32 && djn.sclust == djo.fs->dirbase) ? 0 : djn.sclust; + st_clust(dir, dw); + djo.fs->wflag = 1; + } + } + } + if (res == FR_OK) { + res = dir_remove(&djo); /* Remove old entry */ + if (res == FR_OK) + res = sync(djo.fs); + } + } +/* End critical section */ + } + } + } + FREE_BUF(); + } + LEAVE_FF(djo.fs, res); +} + +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ +#endif /* _FS_MINIMIZE == 0 */ +#endif /* _FS_MINIMIZE <= 1 */ +#endif /* _FS_MINIMIZE <= 2 */ + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Forward data to the stream directly (available on only tiny cfg) */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _USE_FORWARD && _FS_TINY + +FRESULT f_forward ( + FIL *fp, /* Pointer to the file object */ + UINT (*func)(const BYTE*,UINT), /* Pointer to the streaming function */ + UINT btr, /* Number of bytes to forward */ + UINT *bf /* Pointer to number of bytes forwarded */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DWORD remain, clst, sect; + UINT rcnt; + BYTE csect; + + + *bf = 0; /* Clear transfer byte counter */ + + if (!fp) return FR_INVALID_OBJECT; + + res = validate(fp); /* Check validity of the object */ + if (res != FR_OK) LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); + if (fp->flag & FA__ERROR) /* Check error flag */ + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + if (!(fp->flag & FA_READ)) /* Check access mode */ + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_DENIED); + + remain = fp->fsize - fp->fptr; + if (btr > remain) btr = (UINT)remain; /* Truncate btr by remaining bytes */ + + for ( ; btr && (*func)(0, 0); /* Repeat until all data transferred or stream becomes busy */ + fp->fptr += rcnt, *bf += rcnt, btr -= rcnt) { + csect = (BYTE)(fp->fptr / SS(fp->fs) & (fp->fs->csize - 1)); /* Sector offset in the cluster */ + if ((fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)) == 0) { /* On the sector boundary? */ + if (!csect) { /* On the cluster boundary? */ + clst = (fp->fptr == 0) ? /* On the top of the file? */ + fp->sclust : get_fat(fp->fs, fp->clust); + if (clst <= 1) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->clust = clst; /* Update current cluster */ + } + } + sect = clust2sect(fp->fs, fp->clust); /* Get current data sector */ + if (!sect) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + sect += csect; + if (move_window(fp->fs, sect)) /* Move sector window */ + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->dsect = sect; + rcnt = SS(fp->fs) - (WORD)(fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)); /* Forward data from sector window */ + if (rcnt > btr) rcnt = btr; + rcnt = (*func)(&fp->fs->win[(WORD)fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)], rcnt); + if (!rcnt) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + } + + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_OK); +} +#endif /* _USE_FORWARD */ + + + +#if _USE_MKFS && !_FS_READONLY +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Create File System on the Drive */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#define N_ROOTDIR 512 /* Number of root dir entries for FAT12/16 */ +#define N_FATS 1 /* Number of FAT copies (1 or 2) */ + + +FRESULT f_mkfs ( + BYTE drv, /* Logical drive number */ + BYTE sfd, /* Partitioning rule 0:FDISK, 1:SFD */ + UINT au /* Allocation unit size [bytes] */ +) +{ + static const WORD vst[] = { 1024, 512, 256, 128, 64, 32, 16, 8, 4, 2, 0}; + static const WORD cst[] = {32768, 16384, 8192, 4096, 2048, 16384, 8192, 4096, 2048, 1024, 512}; + BYTE fmt, md, sys, *tbl, pdrv, part; + DWORD n_clst, vs, n, wsect; + UINT i; + DWORD b_vol, b_fat, b_dir, b_data; /* LBA */ + DWORD n_vol, n_rsv, n_fat, n_dir; /* Size */ + FATFS *fs; + DSTATUS stat; + + + /* Check mounted drive and clear work area */ + if (drv >= _VOLUMES) return FR_INVALID_DRIVE; + if (sfd > 1) return FR_INVALID_PARAMETER; + if (au & (au - 1)) return FR_INVALID_PARAMETER; + fs = FatFs[drv]; + if (!fs) return FR_NOT_ENABLED; + fs->fs_type = 0; + pdrv = LD2PD(drv); /* Physical drive */ + part = LD2PT(drv); /* Partition (0:auto detect, 1-4:get from partition table)*/ + + /* Get disk statics */ + stat = disk_initialize(pdrv); + if (stat & STA_NOINIT) return FR_NOT_READY; + if (stat & STA_PROTECT) return FR_WRITE_PROTECTED; +#if _MAX_SS != 512 /* Get disk sector size */ + if (disk_ioctl(pdrv, GET_SECTOR_SIZE, &SS(fs)) != RES_OK || SS(fs) > _MAX_SS) + return FR_DISK_ERR; +#endif + if (_MULTI_PARTITION && part) { + /* Get partition information from partition table in the MBR */ + if (disk_read(pdrv, fs->win, 0, 1) != RES_OK) return FR_DISK_ERR; + if (LD_WORD(fs->win+BS_55AA) != 0xAA55) return FR_MKFS_ABORTED; + tbl = &fs->win[MBR_Table + (part - 1) * SZ_PTE]; + if (!tbl[4]) return FR_MKFS_ABORTED; /* No partition? */ + b_vol = LD_DWORD(tbl+8); /* Volume start sector */ + n_vol = LD_DWORD(tbl+12); /* Volume size */ + } else { + /* Create a partition in this function */ + if (disk_ioctl(pdrv, GET_SECTOR_COUNT, &n_vol) != RES_OK || n_vol < 128) + return FR_DISK_ERR; + b_vol = (sfd) ? 0 : 63; /* Volume start sector */ + n_vol -= b_vol; /* Volume size */ + } + + if (!au) { /* AU auto selection */ + vs = n_vol / (2000 / (SS(fs) / 512)); + for (i = 0; vs < vst[i]; i++) ; + au = cst[i]; + } + au /= SS(fs); /* Number of sectors per cluster */ + if (au == 0) au = 1; + if (au > 128) au = 128; + + /* Pre-compute number of clusters and FAT sub-type */ + n_clst = n_vol / au; + fmt = FS_FAT12; + if (n_clst >= MIN_FAT16) fmt = FS_FAT16; + if (n_clst >= MIN_FAT32) fmt = FS_FAT32; + + /* Determine offset and size of FAT structure */ + if (fmt == FS_FAT32) { + n_fat = ((n_clst * 4) + 8 + SS(fs) - 1) / SS(fs); + n_rsv = 32; + n_dir = 0; + } else { + n_fat = (fmt == FS_FAT12) ? (n_clst * 3 + 1) / 2 + 3 : (n_clst * 2) + 4; + n_fat = (n_fat + SS(fs) - 1) / SS(fs); + n_rsv = 1; + n_dir = (DWORD)N_ROOTDIR * SZ_DIR / SS(fs); + } + b_fat = b_vol + n_rsv; /* FAT area start sector */ + b_dir = b_fat + n_fat * N_FATS; /* Directory area start sector */ + b_data = b_dir + n_dir; /* Data area start sector */ + if (n_vol < b_data + au - b_vol) return FR_MKFS_ABORTED; /* Too small volume */ + + /* Align data start sector to erase block boundary (for flash memory media) */ + if (disk_ioctl(pdrv, GET_BLOCK_SIZE, &n) != RES_OK || !n || n > 32768) n = 1; + n = (b_data + n - 1) & ~(n - 1); /* Next nearest erase block from current data start */ + n = (n - b_data) / N_FATS; + if (fmt == FS_FAT32) { /* FAT32: Move FAT offset */ + n_rsv += n; + b_fat += n; + } else { /* FAT12/16: Expand FAT size */ + n_fat += n; + } + + /* Determine number of clusters and final check of validity of the FAT sub-type */ + n_clst = (n_vol - n_rsv - n_fat * N_FATS - n_dir) / au; + if ( (fmt == FS_FAT16 && n_clst < MIN_FAT16) + || (fmt == FS_FAT32 && n_clst < MIN_FAT32)) + return FR_MKFS_ABORTED; + + switch (fmt) { /* Determine system ID for partition table */ + case FS_FAT12: sys = 0x01; break; + case FS_FAT16: sys = (n_vol < 0x10000) ? 0x04 : 0x06; break; + default: sys = 0x0C; + } + + if (_MULTI_PARTITION && part) { + /* Update system ID in the partition table */ + tbl = &fs->win[MBR_Table + (part - 1) * SZ_PTE]; + tbl[4] = sys; + if (disk_write(pdrv, fs->win, 0, 1) != RES_OK) return FR_DISK_ERR; + md = 0xF8; + } else { + if (sfd) { /* No partition table (SFD) */ + md = 0xF0; + } else { /* Create partition table (FDISK) */ + mem_set(fs->win, 0, SS(fs)); + tbl = fs->win+MBR_Table; /* Create partition table for single partition in the drive */ + tbl[1] = 1; /* Partition start head */ + tbl[2] = 1; /* Partition start sector */ + tbl[3] = 0; /* Partition start cylinder */ + tbl[4] = sys; /* System type */ + tbl[5] = 254; /* Partition end head */ + n = (b_vol + n_vol) / 63 / 255; + tbl[6] = (BYTE)((n >> 2) | 63); /* Partition end sector */ + tbl[7] = (BYTE)n; /* End cylinder */ + ST_DWORD(tbl+8, 63); /* Partition start in LBA */ + ST_DWORD(tbl+12, n_vol); /* Partition size in LBA */ + ST_WORD(fs->win+BS_55AA, 0xAA55); /* MBR signature */ + if (disk_write(pdrv, fs->win, 0, 1) != RES_OK) /* Write it to the MBR sector */ + return FR_DISK_ERR; + md = 0xF8; + } + } + + /* Create BPB in the VBR */ + tbl = fs->win; /* Clear sector */ + mem_set(tbl, 0, SS(fs)); + mem_cpy(tbl, "\xEB\xFE\x90" "MSDOS5.0", 11);/* Boot jump code, OEM name */ + i = SS(fs); /* Sector size */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_BytsPerSec, i); + tbl[BPB_SecPerClus] = (BYTE)au; /* Sectors per cluster */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_RsvdSecCnt, n_rsv); /* Reserved sectors */ + tbl[BPB_NumFATs] = N_FATS; /* Number of FATs */ + i = (fmt == FS_FAT32) ? 0 : N_ROOTDIR; /* Number of rootdir entries */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_RootEntCnt, i); + if (n_vol < 0x10000) { /* Number of total sectors */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_TotSec16, n_vol); + } else { + ST_DWORD(tbl+BPB_TotSec32, n_vol); + } + tbl[BPB_Media] = md; /* Media descriptor */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_SecPerTrk, 63); /* Number of sectors per track */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_NumHeads, 255); /* Number of heads */ + ST_DWORD(tbl+BPB_HiddSec, b_vol); /* Hidden sectors */ + n = get_fattime(); /* Use current time as VSN */ + if (fmt == FS_FAT32) { + ST_DWORD(tbl+BS_VolID32, n); /* VSN */ + ST_DWORD(tbl+BPB_FATSz32, n_fat); /* Number of sectors per FAT */ + ST_DWORD(tbl+BPB_RootClus, 2); /* Root directory start cluster (2) */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_FSInfo, 1); /* FSInfo record offset (VBR+1) */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_BkBootSec, 6); /* Backup boot record offset (VBR+6) */ + tbl[BS_DrvNum32] = 0x80; /* Drive number */ + tbl[BS_BootSig32] = 0x29; /* Extended boot signature */ + mem_cpy(tbl+BS_VolLab32, "NO NAME " "FAT32 ", 19); /* Volume label, FAT signature */ + } else { + ST_DWORD(tbl+BS_VolID, n); /* VSN */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_FATSz16, n_fat); /* Number of sectors per FAT */ + tbl[BS_DrvNum] = 0x80; /* Drive number */ + tbl[BS_BootSig] = 0x29; /* Extended boot signature */ + mem_cpy(tbl+BS_VolLab, "NO NAME " "FAT ", 19); /* Volume label, FAT signature */ + } + ST_WORD(tbl+BS_55AA, 0xAA55); /* Signature (Offset is fixed here regardless of sector size) */ + if (disk_write(pdrv, tbl, b_vol, 1) != RES_OK) /* Write it to the VBR sector */ + return FR_DISK_ERR; + if (fmt == FS_FAT32) /* Write backup VBR if needed (VBR+6) */ + disk_write(pdrv, tbl, b_vol + 6, 1); + + /* Initialize FAT area */ + wsect = b_fat; + for (i = 0; i < N_FATS; i++) { /* Initialize each FAT copy */ + mem_set(tbl, 0, SS(fs)); /* 1st sector of the FAT */ + n = md; /* Media descriptor byte */ + if (fmt != FS_FAT32) { + n |= (fmt == FS_FAT12) ? 0x00FFFF00 : 0xFFFFFF00; + ST_DWORD(tbl+0, n); /* Reserve cluster #0-1 (FAT12/16) */ + } else { + n |= 0xFFFFFF00; + ST_DWORD(tbl+0, n); /* Reserve cluster #0-1 (FAT32) */ + ST_DWORD(tbl+4, 0xFFFFFFFF); + ST_DWORD(tbl+8, 0x0FFFFFFF); /* Reserve cluster #2 for root dir */ + } + if (disk_write(pdrv, tbl, wsect++, 1) != RES_OK) + return FR_DISK_ERR; + mem_set(tbl, 0, SS(fs)); /* Fill following FAT entries with zero */ + for (n = 1; n < n_fat; n++) { /* This loop may take a time on FAT32 volume due to many single sector writes */ + if (disk_write(pdrv, tbl, wsect++, 1) != RES_OK) + return FR_DISK_ERR; + } + } + + /* Initialize root directory */ + i = (fmt == FS_FAT32) ? au : n_dir; + do { + if (disk_write(pdrv, tbl, wsect++, 1) != RES_OK) + return FR_DISK_ERR; + } while (--i); + +#if _USE_ERASE /* Erase data area if needed */ + { + DWORD eb[2]; + + eb[0] = wsect; eb[1] = wsect + (n_clst - ((fmt == FS_FAT32) ? 1 : 0)) * au - 1; + disk_ioctl(pdrv, CTRL_ERASE_SECTOR, eb); + } +#endif + + /* Create FSInfo if needed */ + if (fmt == FS_FAT32) { + ST_DWORD(tbl+FSI_LeadSig, 0x41615252); + ST_DWORD(tbl+FSI_StrucSig, 0x61417272); + ST_DWORD(tbl+FSI_Free_Count, n_clst - 1); /* Number of free clusters */ + ST_DWORD(tbl+FSI_Nxt_Free, 2); /* Last allocated cluster# */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BS_55AA, 0xAA55); + disk_write(pdrv, tbl, b_vol + 1, 1); /* Write original (VBR+1) */ + disk_write(pdrv, tbl, b_vol + 7, 1); /* Write backup (VBR+7) */ + } + + return (disk_ioctl(pdrv, CTRL_SYNC, 0) == RES_OK) ? FR_OK : FR_DISK_ERR; +} + + +#if _MULTI_PARTITION == 2 +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Divide Physical Drive */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_fdisk ( + BYTE pdrv, /* Physical drive number */ + const DWORD szt[], /* Pointer to the size table for each partitions */ + void* work /* Pointer to the working buffer */ +) +{ + UINT i, n, sz_cyl, tot_cyl, b_cyl, e_cyl, p_cyl; + BYTE s_hd, e_hd, *p, *buf = (BYTE*)work; + DSTATUS stat; + DWORD sz_disk, sz_part, s_part; + + + stat = disk_initialize(pdrv); + if (stat & STA_NOINIT) return FR_NOT_READY; + if (stat & STA_PROTECT) return FR_WRITE_PROTECTED; + if (disk_ioctl(pdrv, GET_SECTOR_COUNT, &sz_disk)) return FR_DISK_ERR; + + /* Determine CHS in the table regardless of the drive geometry */ + for (n = 16; n < 256 && sz_disk / n / 63 > 1024; n *= 2) ; + if (n == 256) n--; + e_hd = n - 1; + sz_cyl = 63 * n; + tot_cyl = sz_disk / sz_cyl; + + /* Create partition table */ + mem_set(buf, 0, _MAX_SS); + p = buf + MBR_Table; b_cyl = 0; + for (i = 0; i < 4; i++, p += SZ_PTE) { + p_cyl = (szt[i] <= 100) ? (DWORD)tot_cyl * szt[i] / 100 : szt[i] / sz_cyl; + if (!p_cyl) continue; + s_part = (DWORD)sz_cyl * b_cyl; + sz_part = (DWORD)sz_cyl * p_cyl; + if (i == 0) { /* Exclude first track of cylinder 0 */ + s_hd = 1; + s_part += 63; sz_part -= 63; + } else { + s_hd = 0; + } + e_cyl = b_cyl + p_cyl - 1; + if (e_cyl >= tot_cyl) return FR_INVALID_PARAMETER; + + /* Set partition table */ + p[1] = s_hd; /* Start head */ + p[2] = (BYTE)((b_cyl >> 2) + 1); /* Start sector */ + p[3] = (BYTE)b_cyl; /* Start cylinder */ + p[4] = 0x06; /* System type (temporary setting) */ + p[5] = e_hd; /* End head */ + p[6] = (BYTE)((e_cyl >> 2) + 63); /* End sector */ + p[7] = (BYTE)e_cyl; /* End cylinder */ + ST_DWORD(p + 8, s_part); /* Start sector in LBA */ + ST_DWORD(p + 12, sz_part); /* Partition size */ + + /* Next partition */ + b_cyl += p_cyl; + } + ST_WORD(p, 0xAA55); + + /* Write it to the MBR */ + return (disk_write(pdrv, buf, 0, 1) || disk_ioctl(pdrv, CTRL_SYNC, 0)) ? FR_DISK_ERR : FR_OK; +} + + +#endif /* _MULTI_PARTITION == 2 */ +#endif /* _USE_MKFS && !_FS_READONLY */ + + + + +#if _USE_STRFUNC +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Get a string from the file */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +TCHAR* f_gets ( + TCHAR* buff, /* Pointer to the string buffer to read */ + int len, /* Size of string buffer (characters) */ + FIL* fil /* Pointer to the file object */ +) +{ + int n = 0; + TCHAR c, *p = buff; + BYTE s[2]; + UINT rc; + + + while (n < len - 1) { /* Read bytes until buffer gets filled */ + f_read(fil, s, 1, &rc); + if (rc != 1) break; /* Break on EOF or error */ + c = s[0]; +#if _LFN_UNICODE /* Read a character in UTF-8 encoding */ + if (c >= 0x80) { + if (c < 0xC0) continue; /* Skip stray trailer */ + if (c < 0xE0) { /* Two-byte sequence */ + f_read(fil, s, 1, &rc); + if (rc != 1) break; + c = ((c & 0x1F) << 6) | (s[0] & 0x3F); + if (c < 0x80) c = '?'; + } else { + if (c < 0xF0) { /* Three-byte sequence */ + f_read(fil, s, 2, &rc); + if (rc != 2) break; + c = (c << 12) | ((s[0] & 0x3F) << 6) | (s[1] & 0x3F); + if (c < 0x800) c = '?'; + } else { /* Reject four-byte sequence */ + c = '?'; + } + } + } +#endif +#if _USE_STRFUNC >= 2 + if (c == '\r') continue; /* Strip '\r' */ +#endif + *p++ = c; + n++; + if (c == '\n') break; /* Break on EOL */ + } + *p = 0; + return n ? buff : 0; /* When no data read (eof or error), return with error. */ +} + + + +#if !_FS_READONLY +#include <stdarg.h> +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Put a character to the file */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +int f_putc ( + TCHAR c, /* A character to be output */ + FIL* fil /* Pointer to the file object */ +) +{ + UINT bw, btw; + BYTE s[3]; + + +#if _USE_STRFUNC >= 2 + if (c == '\n') f_putc ('\r', fil); /* LF -> CRLF conversion */ +#endif + +#if _LFN_UNICODE /* Write the character in UTF-8 encoding */ + if (c < 0x80) { /* 7-bit */ + s[0] = (BYTE)c; + btw = 1; + } else { + if (c < 0x800) { /* 11-bit */ + s[0] = (BYTE)(0xC0 | (c >> 6)); + s[1] = (BYTE)(0x80 | (c & 0x3F)); + btw = 2; + } else { /* 16-bit */ + s[0] = (BYTE)(0xE0 | (c >> 12)); + s[1] = (BYTE)(0x80 | ((c >> 6) & 0x3F)); + s[2] = (BYTE)(0x80 | (c & 0x3F)); + btw = 3; + } + } +#else /* Write the character without conversion */ + s[0] = (BYTE)c; + btw = 1; +#endif + f_write(fil, s, btw, &bw); /* Write the char to the file */ + return (bw == btw) ? 1 : EOF; /* Return the result */ +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Put a string to the file */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +int f_puts ( + const TCHAR* str, /* Pointer to the string to be output */ + FIL* fil /* Pointer to the file object */ +) +{ + int n; + + + for (n = 0; *str; str++, n++) { + if (f_putc(*str, fil) == EOF) return EOF; + } + return n; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Put a formatted string to the file */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +int f_printf ( + FIL* fil, /* Pointer to the file object */ + const TCHAR* str, /* Pointer to the format string */ + ... /* Optional arguments... */ +) +{ + va_list arp; + BYTE f, r; + UINT i, j, w; + ULONG v; + TCHAR c, d, s[16], *p; + int res, chc, cc; + + + va_start(arp, str); + + for (cc = res = 0; cc != EOF; res += cc) { + c = *str++; + if (c == 0) break; /* End of string */ + if (c != '%') { /* Non escape character */ + cc = f_putc(c, fil); + if (cc != EOF) cc = 1; + continue; + } + w = f = 0; + c = *str++; + if (c == '0') { /* Flag: '0' padding */ + f = 1; c = *str++; + } else { + if (c == '-') { /* Flag: left justified */ + f = 2; c = *str++; + } + } + while (IsDigit(c)) { /* Precision */ + w = w * 10 + c - '0'; + c = *str++; + } + if (c == 'l' || c == 'L') { /* Prefix: Size is long int */ + f |= 4; c = *str++; + } + if (!c) break; + d = c; + if (IsLower(d)) d -= 0x20; + switch (d) { /* Type is... */ + case 'S' : /* String */ + p = va_arg(arp, TCHAR*); + for (j = 0; p[j]; j++) ; + chc = 0; + if (!(f & 2)) { + while (j++ < w) chc += (cc = f_putc(' ', fil)); + } + chc += (cc = f_puts(p, fil)); + while (j++ < w) chc += (cc = f_putc(' ', fil)); + if (cc != EOF) cc = chc; + continue; + case 'C' : /* Character */ + cc = f_putc((TCHAR)va_arg(arp, int), fil); continue; + case 'B' : /* Binary */ + r = 2; break; + case 'O' : /* Octal */ + r = 8; break; + case 'D' : /* Signed decimal */ + case 'U' : /* Unsigned decimal */ + r = 10; break; + case 'X' : /* Hexdecimal */ + r = 16; break; + default: /* Unknown type (pass-through) */ + cc = f_putc(c, fil); continue; + } + + /* Get an argument and put it in numeral */ + v = (f & 4) ? (ULONG)va_arg(arp, long) : ((d == 'D') ? (ULONG)(long)va_arg(arp, int) : (ULONG)va_arg(arp, unsigned int)); + if (d == 'D' && (v & 0x80000000)) { + v = 0 - v; + f |= 8; + } + i = 0; + do { + d = (TCHAR)(v % r); v /= r; + if (d > 9) d += (c == 'x') ? 0x27 : 0x07; + s[i++] = d + '0'; + } while (v && i < sizeof s / sizeof s[0]); + if (f & 8) s[i++] = '-'; + j = i; d = (f & 1) ? '0' : ' '; + res = 0; + while (!(f & 2) && j++ < w) res += (cc = f_putc(d, fil)); + do res += (cc = f_putc(s[--i], fil)); while(i); + while (j++ < w) res += (cc = f_putc(' ', fil)); + if (cc != EOF) cc = res; + } + + va_end(arp); + return (cc == EOF) ? cc : res; +} + +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ +#endif /* _USE_STRFUNC */ diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/ff.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/ff.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..627cbaabe6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/ff.h @@ -0,0 +1,337 @@ +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ FatFs - FAT file system module include file R0.09a (C)ChaN, 2012 +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ FatFs module is a generic FAT file system module for small embedded systems. +/ This is a free software that opened for education, research and commercial +/ developments under license policy of following terms. +/ +/ Copyright (C) 2012, ChaN, all right reserved. +/ +/ * The FatFs module is a free software and there is NO WARRANTY. +/ * No restriction on use. You can use, modify and redistribute it for +/ personal, non-profit or commercial product UNDER YOUR RESPONSIBILITY. +/ * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice. +/ +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#ifndef _FATFS +#define _FATFS 4004 /* Revision ID */ + +#ifdef __cplusplus +extern "C" { +#endif + +#include "integer.h" /* Basic integer types */ +#include "ffconf.h" /* FatFs configuration options */ + +#if _FATFS != _FFCONF +#error Wrong configuration file (ffconf.h). +#endif + + + +/* Definitions of volume management */ + +#if _MULTI_PARTITION /* Multiple partition configuration */ +typedef struct { + BYTE pd; /* Physical drive number */ + BYTE pt; /* Partition: 0:Auto detect, 1-4:Forced partition) */ +} PARTITION; +extern PARTITION VolToPart[]; /* Volume - Partition resolution table */ +#define LD2PD(vol) (VolToPart[vol].pd) /* Get physical drive number */ +#define LD2PT(vol) (VolToPart[vol].pt) /* Get partition index */ + +#else /* Single partition configuration */ +#define LD2PD(vol) (BYTE)(vol) /* Each logical drive is bound to the same physical drive number */ +#define LD2PT(vol) 0 /* Always mounts the 1st partition or in SFD */ + +#endif + + + +/* Type of path name strings on FatFs API */ + +#if _LFN_UNICODE /* Unicode string */ +#if !_USE_LFN +#error _LFN_UNICODE must be 0 in non-LFN cfg. +#endif +#ifndef _INC_TCHAR +typedef WCHAR TCHAR; +#define _T(x) L ## x +#define _TEXT(x) L ## x +#endif + +#else /* ANSI/OEM string */ +#ifndef _INC_TCHAR +typedef char TCHAR; +#define _T(x) x +#define _TEXT(x) x +#endif + +#endif + + + +/* File system object structure (FATFS) */ + +typedef struct { + BYTE fs_type; /* FAT sub-type (0:Not mounted) */ + BYTE drv; /* Physical drive number */ + BYTE csize; /* Sectors per cluster (1,2,4...128) */ + BYTE n_fats; /* Number of FAT copies (1,2) */ + BYTE wflag; /* win[] dirty flag (1:must be written back) */ + BYTE fsi_flag; /* fsinfo dirty flag (1:must be written back) */ + WORD id; /* File system mount ID */ + WORD n_rootdir; /* Number of root directory entries (FAT12/16) */ +#if _MAX_SS != 512 + WORD ssize; /* Bytes per sector (512, 1024, 2048 or 4096) */ +#endif +#if _FS_REENTRANT + _SYNC_t sobj; /* Identifier of sync object */ +#endif +#if !_FS_READONLY + DWORD last_clust; /* Last allocated cluster */ + DWORD free_clust; /* Number of free clusters */ + DWORD fsi_sector; /* fsinfo sector (FAT32) */ +#endif +#if _FS_RPATH + DWORD cdir; /* Current directory start cluster (0:root) */ +#endif + DWORD n_fatent; /* Number of FAT entries (= number of clusters + 2) */ + DWORD fsize; /* Sectors per FAT */ + DWORD fatbase; /* FAT start sector */ + DWORD dirbase; /* Root directory start sector (FAT32:Cluster#) */ + DWORD database; /* Data start sector */ + DWORD winsect; /* Current sector appearing in the win[] */ + BYTE win[_MAX_SS]; /* Disk access window for Directory, FAT (and Data on tiny cfg) */ +} FATFS; + + + +/* File object structure (FIL) */ + +typedef struct { + FATFS* fs; /* Pointer to the related file system object */ + WORD id; /* File system mount ID of the related file system object */ + BYTE flag; /* File status flags */ + BYTE pad1; + DWORD fptr; /* File read/write pointer (0ed on file open) */ + DWORD fsize; /* File size */ + DWORD sclust; /* File data start cluster (0:no data cluster, always 0 when fsize is 0) */ + DWORD clust; /* Current cluster of fpter */ + DWORD dsect; /* Current data sector of fpter */ +#if !_FS_READONLY + DWORD dir_sect; /* Sector containing the directory entry */ + BYTE* dir_ptr; /* Pointer to the directory entry in the window */ +#endif +#if _USE_FASTSEEK + DWORD* cltbl; /* Pointer to the cluster link map table (null on file open) */ +#endif +#if _FS_LOCK + UINT lockid; /* File lock ID (index of file semaphore table Files[]) */ +#endif +#if !_FS_TINY + BYTE buf[_MAX_SS]; /* File data read/write buffer */ +#endif +} FIL; + + + +/* Directory object structure (DIR) */ + +typedef struct { + FATFS* fs; /* Pointer to the owner file system object */ + WORD id; /* Owner file system mount ID */ + WORD index; /* Current read/write index number */ + DWORD sclust; /* Table start cluster (0:Root dir) */ + DWORD clust; /* Current cluster */ + DWORD sect; /* Current sector */ + BYTE* dir; /* Pointer to the current SFN entry in the win[] */ + BYTE* fn; /* Pointer to the SFN (in/out) {file[8],ext[3],status[1]} */ +#if _USE_LFN + WCHAR* lfn; /* Pointer to the LFN working buffer */ + WORD lfn_idx; /* Last matched LFN index number (0xFFFF:No LFN) */ +#endif +} DIR; + + + +/* File status structure (FILINFO) */ + +typedef struct { + DWORD fsize; /* File size */ + WORD fdate; /* Last modified date */ + WORD ftime; /* Last modified time */ + BYTE fattrib; /* Attribute */ + TCHAR fname[13]; /* Short file name (8.3 format) */ +#if _USE_LFN + TCHAR* lfname; /* Pointer to the LFN buffer */ + UINT lfsize; /* Size of LFN buffer in TCHAR */ +#endif +} FILINFO; + + + +/* File function return code (FRESULT) */ + +typedef enum { + FR_OK = 0, /* (0) Succeeded */ + FR_DISK_ERR, /* (1) A hard error occurred in the low level disk I/O layer */ + FR_INT_ERR, /* (2) Assertion failed */ + FR_NOT_READY, /* (3) The physical drive cannot work */ + FR_NO_FILE, /* (4) Could not find the file */ + FR_NO_PATH, /* (5) Could not find the path */ + FR_INVALID_NAME, /* (6) The path name format is invalid */ + FR_DENIED, /* (7) Access denied due to prohibited access or directory full */ + FR_EXIST, /* (8) Access denied due to prohibited access */ + FR_INVALID_OBJECT, /* (9) The file/directory object is invalid */ + FR_WRITE_PROTECTED, /* (10) The physical drive is write protected */ + FR_INVALID_DRIVE, /* (11) The logical drive number is invalid */ + FR_NOT_ENABLED, /* (12) The volume has no work area */ + FR_NO_FILESYSTEM, /* (13) There is no valid FAT volume */ + FR_MKFS_ABORTED, /* (14) The f_mkfs() aborted due to any parameter error */ + FR_TIMEOUT, /* (15) Could not get a grant to access the volume within defined period */ + FR_LOCKED, /* (16) The operation is rejected according to the file sharing policy */ + FR_NOT_ENOUGH_CORE, /* (17) LFN working buffer could not be allocated */ + FR_TOO_MANY_OPEN_FILES, /* (18) Number of open files > _FS_SHARE */ + FR_INVALID_PARAMETER /* (19) Given parameter is invalid */ +} FRESULT; + + + +/*--------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* FatFs module application interface */ + +FRESULT f_mount (BYTE, FATFS*); /* Mount/Unmount a logical drive */ +FRESULT f_open (FIL*, const TCHAR*, BYTE); /* Open or create a file */ +FRESULT f_read (FIL*, void*, UINT, UINT*); /* Read data from a file */ +FRESULT f_lseek (FIL*, DWORD); /* Move file pointer of a file object */ +FRESULT f_close (FIL*); /* Close an open file object */ +FRESULT f_opendir (DIR*, const TCHAR*); /* Open an existing directory */ +FRESULT f_readdir (DIR*, FILINFO*); /* Read a directory item */ +FRESULT f_stat (const TCHAR*, FILINFO*); /* Get file status */ +FRESULT f_write (FIL*, const void*, UINT, UINT*); /* Write data to a file */ +FRESULT f_getfree (const TCHAR*, DWORD*, FATFS**); /* Get number of free clusters on the drive */ +FRESULT f_truncate (FIL*); /* Truncate file */ +FRESULT f_sync (FIL*); /* Flush cached data of a writing file */ +FRESULT f_unlink (const TCHAR*); /* Delete an existing file or directory */ +FRESULT f_mkdir (const TCHAR*); /* Create a new directory */ +FRESULT f_chmod (const TCHAR*, BYTE, BYTE); /* Change attribute of the file/dir */ +FRESULT f_utime (const TCHAR*, const FILINFO*); /* Change times-tamp of the file/dir */ +FRESULT f_rename (const TCHAR*, const TCHAR*); /* Rename/Move a file or directory */ +FRESULT f_chdrive (BYTE); /* Change current drive */ +FRESULT f_chdir (const TCHAR*); /* Change current directory */ +FRESULT f_getcwd (TCHAR*, UINT); /* Get current directory */ +FRESULT f_forward (FIL*, UINT(*)(const BYTE*,UINT), UINT, UINT*); /* Forward data to the stream */ +FRESULT f_mkfs (BYTE, BYTE, UINT); /* Create a file system on the drive */ +FRESULT f_fdisk (BYTE, const DWORD[], void*); /* Divide a physical drive into some partitions */ +int f_putc (TCHAR, FIL*); /* Put a character to the file */ +int f_puts (const TCHAR*, FIL*); /* Put a string to the file */ +int f_printf (FIL*, const TCHAR*, ...); /* Put a formatted string to the file */ +TCHAR* f_gets (TCHAR*, int, FIL*); /* Get a string from the file */ + +#define f_eof(fp) (((fp)->fptr == (fp)->fsize) ? 1 : 0) +#define f_error(fp) (((fp)->flag & FA__ERROR) ? 1 : 0) +#define f_tell(fp) ((fp)->fptr) +#define f_size(fp) ((fp)->fsize) + +#ifndef EOF +#define EOF (-1) +#endif + + + + +/*--------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Additional user defined functions */ + +/* RTC function */ +#if !_FS_READONLY +DWORD get_fattime (void); +#endif + +/* Unicode support functions */ +#if _USE_LFN /* Unicode - OEM code conversion */ +WCHAR ff_convert (WCHAR, UINT); /* OEM-Unicode bidirectional conversion */ +WCHAR ff_wtoupper (WCHAR); /* Unicode upper-case conversion */ +#if _USE_LFN == 3 /* Memory functions */ +void* ff_memalloc (UINT); /* Allocate memory block */ +void ff_memfree (void*); /* Free memory block */ +#endif +#endif + +/* Sync functions */ +#if _FS_REENTRANT +int ff_cre_syncobj (BYTE, _SYNC_t*);/* Create a sync object */ +int ff_req_grant (_SYNC_t); /* Lock sync object */ +void ff_rel_grant (_SYNC_t); /* Unlock sync object */ +int ff_del_syncobj (_SYNC_t); /* Delete a sync object */ +#endif + + + + +/*--------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Flags and offset address */ + + +/* File access control and file status flags (FIL.flag) */ + +#define FA_READ 0x01 +#define FA_OPEN_EXISTING 0x00 +#define FA__ERROR 0x80 + +#if !_FS_READONLY +#define FA_WRITE 0x02 +#define FA_CREATE_NEW 0x04 +#define FA_CREATE_ALWAYS 0x08 +#define FA_OPEN_ALWAYS 0x10 +#define FA__WRITTEN 0x20 +#define FA__DIRTY 0x40 +#endif + + +/* FAT sub type (FATFS.fs_type) */ + +#define FS_FAT12 1 +#define FS_FAT16 2 +#define FS_FAT32 3 + + +/* File attribute bits for directory entry */ + +#define AM_RDO 0x01 /* Read only */ +#define AM_HID 0x02 /* Hidden */ +#define AM_SYS 0x04 /* System */ +#define AM_VOL 0x08 /* Volume label */ +#define AM_LFN 0x0F /* LFN entry */ +#define AM_DIR 0x10 /* Directory */ +#define AM_ARC 0x20 /* Archive */ +#define AM_MASK 0x3F /* Mask of defined bits */ + + +/* Fast seek feature */ +#define CREATE_LINKMAP 0xFFFFFFFF + + + +/*--------------------------------*/ +/* Multi-byte word access macros */ + +#if _WORD_ACCESS == 1 /* Enable word access to the FAT structure */ +#define LD_WORD(ptr) (WORD)(*(WORD*)(BYTE*)(ptr)) +#define LD_DWORD(ptr) (DWORD)(*(DWORD*)(BYTE*)(ptr)) +#define ST_WORD(ptr,val) *(WORD*)(BYTE*)(ptr)=(WORD)(val) +#define ST_DWORD(ptr,val) *(DWORD*)(BYTE*)(ptr)=(DWORD)(val) +#else /* Use byte-by-byte access to the FAT structure */ +#define LD_WORD(ptr) (WORD)(((WORD)*((BYTE*)(ptr)+1)<<8)|(WORD)*(BYTE*)(ptr)) +#define LD_DWORD(ptr) (DWORD)(((DWORD)*((BYTE*)(ptr)+3)<<24)|((DWORD)*((BYTE*)(ptr)+2)<<16)|((WORD)*((BYTE*)(ptr)+1)<<8)|*(BYTE*)(ptr)) +#define ST_WORD(ptr,val) *(BYTE*)(ptr)=(BYTE)(val); *((BYTE*)(ptr)+1)=(BYTE)((WORD)(val)>>8) +#define ST_DWORD(ptr,val) *(BYTE*)(ptr)=(BYTE)(val); *((BYTE*)(ptr)+1)=(BYTE)((WORD)(val)>>8); *((BYTE*)(ptr)+2)=(BYTE)((DWORD)(val)>>16); *((BYTE*)(ptr)+3)=(BYTE)((DWORD)(val)>>24) +#endif + +#ifdef __cplusplus +} +#endif + +#endif /* _FATFS */ diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/ffconf.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/ffconf.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..63a4e78236 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/ffconf.h @@ -0,0 +1,191 @@ +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ FatFs - FAT file system module configuration file R0.09a (C)ChaN, 2012 +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ +/ CAUTION! Do not forget to make clean the project after any changes to +/ the configuration options. +/ +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#ifndef _FFCONF +#define _FFCONF 4004 /* Revision ID */ + + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ Function and Buffer Configurations +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#define _FS_TINY 1 /* 0:Normal or 1:Tiny */ +/* When _FS_TINY is set to 1, FatFs uses the sector buffer in the file system +/ object instead of the sector buffer in the individual file object for file +/ data transfer. This reduces memory consumption 512 bytes each file object. */ + + +#define _FS_READONLY 0 /* 0:Read/Write or 1:Read only */ +/* Setting _FS_READONLY to 1 defines read only configuration. This removes +/ writing functions, f_write, f_sync, f_unlink, f_mkdir, f_chmod, f_rename, +/ f_truncate and useless f_getfree. */ + + +#define _FS_MINIMIZE 2 /* 0 to 3 */ +/* The _FS_MINIMIZE option defines minimization level to remove some functions. +/ +/ 0: Full function. +/ 1: f_stat, f_getfree, f_unlink, f_mkdir, f_chmod, f_truncate and f_rename +/ are removed. +/ 2: f_opendir and f_readdir are removed in addition to 1. +/ 3: f_lseek is removed in addition to 2. */ + + +#define _USE_STRFUNC 0 /* 0:Disable or 1-2:Enable */ +/* To enable string functions, set _USE_STRFUNC to 1 or 2. */ + + +#define _USE_MKFS 0 /* 0:Disable or 1:Enable */ +/* To enable f_mkfs function, set _USE_MKFS to 1 and set _FS_READONLY to 0 */ + + +#define _USE_FORWARD 0 /* 0:Disable or 1:Enable */ +/* To enable f_forward function, set _USE_FORWARD to 1 and set _FS_TINY to 1. */ + + +#define _USE_FASTSEEK 0 /* 0:Disable or 1:Enable */ +/* To enable fast seek feature, set _USE_FASTSEEK to 1. */ + + + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ Locale and Namespace Configurations +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#define _CODE_PAGE 932 +/* The _CODE_PAGE specifies the OEM code page to be used on the target system. +/ Incorrect setting of the code page can cause a file open failure. +/ +/ 932 - Japanese Shift-JIS (DBCS, OEM, Windows) +/ 936 - Simplified Chinese GBK (DBCS, OEM, Windows) +/ 949 - Korean (DBCS, OEM, Windows) +/ 950 - Traditional Chinese Big5 (DBCS, OEM, Windows) +/ 1250 - Central Europe (Windows) +/ 1251 - Cyrillic (Windows) +/ 1252 - Latin 1 (Windows) +/ 1253 - Greek (Windows) +/ 1254 - Turkish (Windows) +/ 1255 - Hebrew (Windows) +/ 1256 - Arabic (Windows) +/ 1257 - Baltic (Windows) +/ 1258 - Vietnam (OEM, Windows) +/ 437 - U.S. (OEM) +/ 720 - Arabic (OEM) +/ 737 - Greek (OEM) +/ 775 - Baltic (OEM) +/ 850 - Multilingual Latin 1 (OEM) +/ 858 - Multilingual Latin 1 + Euro (OEM) +/ 852 - Latin 2 (OEM) +/ 855 - Cyrillic (OEM) +/ 866 - Russian (OEM) +/ 857 - Turkish (OEM) +/ 862 - Hebrew (OEM) +/ 874 - Thai (OEM, Windows) +/ 1 - ASCII only (Valid for non LFN cfg.) +*/ + + +#define _USE_LFN 0 /* 0 to 3 */ +#define _MAX_LFN 255 /* Maximum LFN length to handle (12 to 255) */ +/* The _USE_LFN option switches the LFN support. +/ +/ 0: Disable LFN feature. _MAX_LFN and _LFN_UNICODE have no effect. +/ 1: Enable LFN with static working buffer on the BSS. Always NOT reentrant. +/ 2: Enable LFN with dynamic working buffer on the STACK. +/ 3: Enable LFN with dynamic working buffer on the HEAP. +/ +/ The LFN working buffer occupies (_MAX_LFN + 1) * 2 bytes. To enable LFN, +/ Unicode handling functions ff_convert() and ff_wtoupper() must be added +/ to the project. When enable to use heap, memory control functions +/ ff_memalloc() and ff_memfree() must be added to the project. */ + + +#define _LFN_UNICODE 0 /* 0:ANSI/OEM or 1:Unicode */ +/* To switch the character code set on FatFs API to Unicode, +/ enable LFN feature and set _LFN_UNICODE to 1. */ + + +#define _FS_RPATH 0 /* 0 to 2 */ +/* The _FS_RPATH option configures relative path feature. +/ +/ 0: Disable relative path feature and remove related functions. +/ 1: Enable relative path. f_chdrive() and f_chdir() are available. +/ 2: f_getcwd() is available in addition to 1. +/ +/ Note that output of the f_readdir fnction is affected by this option. */ + + + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ Physical Drive Configurations +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#define _VOLUMES 1 +/* Number of volumes (logical drives) to be used. */ + + +#define _MAX_SS 512 /* 512, 1024, 2048 or 4096 */ +/* Maximum sector size to be handled. +/ Always set 512 for memory card and hard disk but a larger value may be +/ required for on-board flash memory, floppy disk and optical disk. +/ When _MAX_SS is larger than 512, it configures FatFs to variable sector size +/ and GET_SECTOR_SIZE command must be implememted to the disk_ioctl function. */ + + +#define _MULTI_PARTITION 0 /* 0:Single partition, 1/2:Enable multiple partition */ +/* When set to 0, each volume is bound to the same physical drive number and +/ it can mount only first primaly partition. When it is set to 1, each volume +/ is tied to the partitions listed in VolToPart[]. */ + + +#define _USE_ERASE 0 /* 0:Disable or 1:Enable */ +/* To enable sector erase feature, set _USE_ERASE to 1. CTRL_ERASE_SECTOR command +/ should be added to the disk_ioctl functio. */ + + + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ System Configurations +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#define _WORD_ACCESS 1 /* 0 or 1 */ +/* Set 0 first and it is always compatible with all platforms. The _WORD_ACCESS +/ option defines which access method is used to the word data on the FAT volume. +/ +/ 0: Byte-by-byte access. +/ 1: Word access. Do not choose this unless following condition is met. +/ +/ When the byte order on the memory is big-endian or address miss-aligned word +/ access results incorrect behavior, the _WORD_ACCESS must be set to 0. +/ If it is not the case, the value can also be set to 1 to improve the +/ performance and code size. +*/ + + +/* A header file that defines sync object types on the O/S, such as +/ windows.h, ucos_ii.h and semphr.h, must be included prior to ff.h. */ + +#define _FS_REENTRANT 0 /* 0:Disable or 1:Enable */ +#define _FS_TIMEOUT 1000 /* Timeout period in unit of time ticks */ +#define _SYNC_t HANDLE /* O/S dependent type of sync object. e.g. HANDLE, OS_EVENT*, ID and etc.. */ + +/* The _FS_REENTRANT option switches the reentrancy (thread safe) of the FatFs module. +/ +/ 0: Disable reentrancy. _SYNC_t and _FS_TIMEOUT have no effect. +/ 1: Enable reentrancy. Also user provided synchronization handlers, +/ ff_req_grant, ff_rel_grant, ff_del_syncobj and ff_cre_syncobj +/ function must be added to the project. */ + + +#define _FS_LOCK 0 /* 0:Disable or >=1:Enable */ +/* To enable file lock control feature, set _FS_LOCK to 1 or greater. + The value defines how many files can be opened simultaneously. */ + + +#endif /* _FFCONFIG */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/integer.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/integer.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5408fe6b3e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/FATFs/integer.h @@ -0,0 +1,38 @@ +/*-------------------------------------------*/ +/* Integer type definitions for FatFs module */ +/*-------------------------------------------*/ + +#ifndef _INTEGER +#define _INTEGER + +#ifdef _WIN32 /* FatFs development platform */ + +#include <windows.h> +#include <tchar.h> + +#else /* Embedded platform */ + +/* These types must be 16-bit, 32-bit or larger integer */ +typedef int INT; +typedef unsigned int UINT; + +/* These types must be 8-bit integer */ +typedef char CHAR; +typedef unsigned char UCHAR; +typedef unsigned char BYTE; + +/* These types must be 16-bit integer */ +typedef short SHORT; +typedef unsigned short USHORT; +typedef unsigned short WORD; +typedef unsigned short WCHAR; + +/* These types must be 32-bit integer */ +typedef long LONG; +typedef unsigned long ULONG; +typedef unsigned long DWORD; + +#endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/RTC.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/RTC.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a5291eaf3c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/RTC.c @@ -0,0 +1,159 @@ +/* + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +#include "RTC.h" + +#if defined(DUMMY_RTC) + +/** Current dummy RTC time and date */ +static volatile TimeDate_t DummyRTC_Count; + +void RTC_Init(void) +{ + DummyRTC_Count.Hour = 0; + DummyRTC_Count.Minute = 0; + DummyRTC_Count.Second = 0; + DummyRTC_Count.Day = 1; + DummyRTC_Count.Month = 1; + DummyRTC_Count.Year = 00; +} + +void RTC_Tick500ms(void) +{ + static bool HalfSecondElapsed = false; + + HalfSecondElapsed = !HalfSecondElapsed; + if (HalfSecondElapsed == false) + return; + + if (++DummyRTC_Count.Second < 60) + return; + + DummyRTC_Count.Second = 0; + + if (++DummyRTC_Count.Minute < 60) + return; + + DummyRTC_Count.Minute = 0; + + if (++DummyRTC_Count.Hour < 24) + return; + + DummyRTC_Count.Hour = 0; + + static const char MonthLength[12] = {31, 28, 31, 30, 31, 30, 31, 31, 30, 31, 30, 31}; + uint8_t DaysInMonth = MonthLength[DummyRTC_Count.Month - 1]; + + /* Check if we need to account for a leap year */ + if ((DummyRTC_Count.Month == 2) && + ((!(DummyRTC_Count.Year % 400)) || ((DummyRTC_Count.Year % 100) && !(DummyRTC_Count.Year % 4)))) + { + DaysInMonth++; + } + + if (++DummyRTC_Count.Day <= DaysInMonth) + return; + + DummyRTC_Count.Day = 1; + + if (++DummyRTC_Count.Month <= 12) + return; + + DummyRTC_Count.Month = 1; + DummyRTC_Count.Year++; +} + +bool RTC_SetTimeDate(const TimeDate_t* NewTimeDate) +{ + GlobalInterruptDisable(); + DummyRTC_Count = *NewTimeDate; + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + return true; +} + +bool RTC_GetTimeDate(TimeDate_t* const TimeDate) +{ + GlobalInterruptDisable(); + *TimeDate = DummyRTC_Count; + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + return true; +} + +#else + +void RTC_Init(void) +{ + /* Unused for a real external DS1307 RTC device */ +} + +void RTC_Tick500ms(void) +{ + /* Unused for a real external DS1307 RTC device */ +} + +bool RTC_SetTimeDate(const TimeDate_t* NewTimeDate) +{ + DS1307_DateTimeRegs_t NewRegValues; + const uint8_t WriteAddress = 0; + + // Convert new time data to the DS1307's time register layout + NewRegValues.Byte1.Fields.TenSec = (NewTimeDate->Second / 10); + NewRegValues.Byte1.Fields.Sec = (NewTimeDate->Second % 10); + NewRegValues.Byte1.Fields.CH = false; + NewRegValues.Byte2.Fields.TenMin = (NewTimeDate->Minute / 10); + NewRegValues.Byte2.Fields.Min = (NewTimeDate->Minute % 10); + NewRegValues.Byte3.Fields.TenHour = (NewTimeDate->Hour / 10); + NewRegValues.Byte3.Fields.Hour = (NewTimeDate->Hour % 10); + NewRegValues.Byte3.Fields.TwelveHourMode = false; + + // Convert new date data to the DS1307's date register layout + NewRegValues.Byte4.Fields.DayOfWeek = 0; + NewRegValues.Byte5.Fields.TenDay = (NewTimeDate->Day / 10); + NewRegValues.Byte5.Fields.Day = (NewTimeDate->Day % 10); + NewRegValues.Byte6.Fields.TenMonth = (NewTimeDate->Month / 10); + NewRegValues.Byte6.Fields.Month = (NewTimeDate->Month % 10); + NewRegValues.Byte7.Fields.TenYear = (NewTimeDate->Year / 10); + NewRegValues.Byte7.Fields.Year = (NewTimeDate->Year % 10); + + // Write the new Time and Date into the DS1307 + if (TWI_WritePacket(DS1307_ADDRESS, 10, &WriteAddress, sizeof(WriteAddress), + (uint8_t*)&NewRegValues, sizeof(DS1307_DateTimeRegs_t)) != TWI_ERROR_NoError) + { + return false; + } + + return true; +} + +bool RTC_GetTimeDate(TimeDate_t* const TimeDate) +{ + DS1307_DateTimeRegs_t CurrentRegValues; + const uint8_t ReadAddress = 0; + + // Read in the stored Time and Date from the DS1307 + if (TWI_ReadPacket(DS1307_ADDRESS, 10, &ReadAddress, sizeof(ReadAddress), + (uint8_t*)&CurrentRegValues, sizeof(DS1307_DateTimeRegs_t)) != TWI_ERROR_NoError) + { + return false; + } + + // Convert stored time value into decimal + TimeDate->Second = (CurrentRegValues.Byte1.Fields.TenSec * 10) + CurrentRegValues.Byte1.Fields.Sec; + TimeDate->Minute = (CurrentRegValues.Byte2.Fields.TenMin * 10) + CurrentRegValues.Byte2.Fields.Min; + TimeDate->Hour = (CurrentRegValues.Byte3.Fields.TenHour * 10) + CurrentRegValues.Byte3.Fields.Hour; + + // Convert stored date value into decimal + TimeDate->Day = (CurrentRegValues.Byte5.Fields.TenDay * 10) + CurrentRegValues.Byte5.Fields.Day; + TimeDate->Month = (CurrentRegValues.Byte6.Fields.TenMonth * 10) + CurrentRegValues.Byte6.Fields.Month; + TimeDate->Year = (CurrentRegValues.Byte7.Fields.TenYear * 10) + CurrentRegValues.Byte7.Fields.Year; + + return true; +} + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/RTC.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/RTC.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f35b8ff1ec --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/RTC.h @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +#ifndef _RTC_H_ +#define _RTC_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/TWI.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Type Defines: */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Hour; + uint8_t Minute; + uint8_t Second; + uint8_t Day; + uint8_t Month; + uint8_t Year; + } TimeDate_t; + + typedef struct + { + union + { + struct + { + unsigned Sec : 4; + unsigned TenSec : 3; + unsigned CH : 1; + } Fields; + + uint8_t IntVal; + } Byte1; + + union + { + struct + { + unsigned Min : 4; + unsigned TenMin : 3; + unsigned Reserved : 1; + } Fields; + + uint8_t IntVal; + } Byte2; + + union + { + struct + { + unsigned Hour : 4; + unsigned TenHour : 2; + unsigned TwelveHourMode : 1; + unsigned Reserved : 1; + } Fields; + + uint8_t IntVal; + } Byte3; + + union + { + struct + { + unsigned DayOfWeek : 3; + unsigned Reserved : 5; + } Fields; + + uint8_t IntVal; + } Byte4; + + union + { + struct + { + unsigned Day : 4; + unsigned TenDay : 2; + unsigned Reserved : 2; + } Fields; + + uint8_t IntVal; + } Byte5; + + union + { + struct + { + unsigned Month : 4; + unsigned TenMonth : 1; + unsigned Reserved : 3; + } Fields; + + uint8_t IntVal; + } Byte6; + + union + { + struct + { + unsigned Year : 4; + unsigned TenYear : 4; + } Fields; + + uint8_t IntVal; + } Byte7; + } DS1307_DateTimeRegs_t; + + /* Macros: */ + /** TWI address of the DS1307 device on the bus. */ + #define DS1307_ADDRESS 0xD0 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void RTC_Init(void); + void RTC_Tick500ms(void); + bool RTC_SetTimeDate(const TimeDate_t* NewTimeDate); + bool RTC_GetTimeDate(TimeDate_t* const TimeDate); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/SCSI.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/SCSI.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4fbbfd60e8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/SCSI.c @@ -0,0 +1,344 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * SCSI command processing routines, for SCSI commands issued by the host. Mass Storage + * devices use a thin "Bulk-Only Transport" protocol for issuing commands and status information, + * which wrap around standard SCSI device commands for controlling the actual storage medium. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_SCSI_C +#include "SCSI.h" + +/** Structure to hold the SCSI response data to a SCSI INQUIRY command. This gives information about the device's + * features and capabilities. + */ +static const SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t InquiryData = + { + .DeviceType = DEVICE_TYPE_BLOCK, + .PeripheralQualifier = 0, + + .Removable = true, + + .Version = 0, + + .ResponseDataFormat = 2, + .NormACA = false, + .TrmTsk = false, + .AERC = false, + + .AdditionalLength = 0x1F, + + .SoftReset = false, + .CmdQue = false, + .Linked = false, + .Sync = false, + .WideBus16Bit = false, + .WideBus32Bit = false, + .RelAddr = false, + + .VendorID = "LUFA", + .ProductID = "Dataflash Disk", + .RevisionID = {'0','.','0','0'}, + }; + +/** Structure to hold the sense data for the last issued SCSI command, which is returned to the host after a SCSI REQUEST SENSE + * command is issued. This gives information on exactly why the last command failed to complete. + */ +static SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t SenseData = + { + .ResponseCode = 0x70, + .AdditionalLength = 0x0A, + }; + + +/** Main routine to process the SCSI command located in the Command Block Wrapper read from the host. This dispatches + * to the appropriate SCSI command handling routine if the issued command is supported by the device, else it returns + * a command failure due to a ILLEGAL REQUEST. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise + */ +bool SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + bool CommandSuccess = false; + + /* Run the appropriate SCSI command hander function based on the passed command */ + switch (MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[0]) + { + case SCSI_CMD_INQUIRY: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Inquiry(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_REQUEST_SENSE: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_READ_CAPACITY_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_SEND_DIAGNOSTIC: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_WRITE_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(MSInterfaceInfo, DATA_WRITE); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_READ_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(MSInterfaceInfo, DATA_READ); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_MODE_SENSE_6: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_START_STOP_UNIT: + case SCSI_CMD_TEST_UNIT_READY: + case SCSI_CMD_PREVENT_ALLOW_MEDIUM_REMOVAL: + case SCSI_CMD_VERIFY_10: + /* These commands should just succeed, no handling required */ + CommandSuccess = true; + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength = 0; + break; + default: + /* Update the SENSE key to reflect the invalid command */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_COMMAND, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + break; + } + + /* Check if command was successfully processed */ + if (CommandSuccess) + { + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_GOOD, + SCSI_ASENSE_NO_ADDITIONAL_INFORMATION, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return true; + } + + return false; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI INQUIRY command. This command returns information about the device's features + * and capabilities to the host. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Inquiry(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint16_t AllocationLength = SwapEndian_16(*(uint16_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[3]); + uint16_t BytesTransferred = MIN(AllocationLength, sizeof(InquiryData)); + + /* Only the standard INQUIRY data is supported, check if any optional INQUIRY bits set */ + if ((MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[1] & ((1 << 0) | (1 << 1))) || + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[2]) + { + /* Optional but unsupported bits set - update the SENSE key and fail the request */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_FIELD_IN_CDB, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&InquiryData, BytesTransferred, NULL); + + /* Pad out remaining bytes with 0x00 */ + Endpoint_Null_Stream((AllocationLength - BytesTransferred), NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= BytesTransferred; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI REQUEST SENSE command. This command returns information about the last issued command, + * including the error code and additional error information so that the host can determine why a command failed to complete. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint8_t AllocationLength = MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[4]; + uint8_t BytesTransferred = MIN(AllocationLength, sizeof(SenseData)); + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&SenseData, BytesTransferred, NULL); + Endpoint_Null_Stream((AllocationLength - BytesTransferred), NULL); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= BytesTransferred; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI READ CAPACITY (10) command. This command returns information about the device's capacity + * on the selected Logical Unit (drive), as a number of OS-sized blocks. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint32_t LastBlockAddressInLUN = (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCKS - 1); + uint32_t MediaBlockSize = VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE; + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE(&LastBlockAddressInLUN, sizeof(LastBlockAddressInLUN), NULL); + Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE(&MediaBlockSize, sizeof(MediaBlockSize), NULL); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= 8; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI SEND DIAGNOSTIC command. This command performs a quick check of the Dataflash ICs on the + * board, and indicates if they are present and functioning correctly. Only the Self-Test portion of the diagnostic command is + * supported. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + /* Check to see if the SELF TEST bit is not set */ + if (!(MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[1] & (1 << 2))) + { + /* Only self-test supported - update SENSE key and fail the command */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_FIELD_IN_CDB, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Check to see if all attached Dataflash ICs are functional */ + if (!(DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation())) + { + /* Update SENSE key with a hardware error condition and return command fail */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_HARDWARE_ERROR, + SCSI_ASENSE_NO_ADDITIONAL_INFORMATION, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength = 0; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI READ (10) or WRITE (10) command. This command reads in the block start address + * and total number of blocks to process, then calls the appropriate low-level Dataflash routine to handle the actual + * reading and writing of the data. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * \param[in] IsDataRead Indicates if the command is a READ (10) command or WRITE (10) command (DATA_READ or DATA_WRITE) + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const bool IsDataRead) +{ + uint32_t BlockAddress; + uint16_t TotalBlocks; + + /* Check if the disk is write protected or not */ + if ((IsDataRead == DATA_WRITE) && DISK_READ_ONLY) + { + /* Block address is invalid, update SENSE key and return command fail */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_DATA_PROTECT, + SCSI_ASENSE_WRITE_PROTECTED, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Load in the 32-bit block address (SCSI uses big-endian, so have to reverse the byte order) */ + BlockAddress = SwapEndian_32(*(uint32_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[2]); + + /* Load in the 16-bit total blocks (SCSI uses big-endian, so have to reverse the byte order) */ + TotalBlocks = SwapEndian_16(*(uint16_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[7]); + + /* Check if the block address is outside the maximum allowable value for the LUN */ + if (BlockAddress >= VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCKS) + { + /* Block address is invalid, update SENSE key and return command fail */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_LOGICAL_BLOCK_ADDRESS_OUT_OF_RANGE, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Determine if the packet is a READ (10) or WRITE (10) command, call appropriate function */ + if (IsDataRead == DATA_READ) + DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(MSInterfaceInfo, BlockAddress, TotalBlocks); + else + DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(MSInterfaceInfo, BlockAddress, TotalBlocks); + + /* Update the bytes transferred counter and succeed the command */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= ((uint32_t)TotalBlocks * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE); + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI MODE SENSE (6) command. This command returns various informational pages about + * the SCSI device, as well as the device's Write Protect status. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + /* Send an empty header response with the Write Protect flag status */ + Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); + Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); + Endpoint_Write_8(DISK_READ_ONLY ? 0x80 : 0x00); + Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Update the bytes transferred counter and succeed the command */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= 4; + + return true; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/SCSI.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/SCSI.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..494b31bf8c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/Lib/SCSI.h @@ -0,0 +1,89 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for SCSI.c. + */ + +#ifndef _SCSI_H_ +#define _SCSI_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "../TempDataLogger.h" + #include "../Descriptors.h" + #include "DataflashManager.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Macro to set the current SCSI sense data to the given key, additional sense code and additional sense qualifier. This + * is for convenience, as it allows for all three sense values (returned upon request to the host to give information about + * the last command failure) in a quick and easy manner. + * + * \param[in] Key New SCSI sense key to set the sense code to + * \param[in] Acode New SCSI additional sense key to set the additional sense code to + * \param[in] Aqual New SCSI additional sense key qualifier to set the additional sense qualifier code to + */ + #define SCSI_SET_SENSE(Key, Acode, Aqual) do { SenseData.SenseKey = (Key); \ + SenseData.AdditionalSenseCode = (Acode); \ + SenseData.AdditionalSenseQualifier = (Aqual); } while (0) + + /** Macro for the \ref SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10() function, to indicate that data is to be read from the storage medium. */ + #define DATA_READ true + + /** Macro for the \ref SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10() function, to indicate that data is to be written to the storage medium. */ + #define DATA_WRITE false + + /** Value for the DeviceType entry in the SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t enum, indicating a Block Media device. */ + #define DEVICE_TYPE_BLOCK 0x00 + + /** Value for the DeviceType entry in the SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t enum, indicating a CD-ROM device. */ + #define DEVICE_TYPE_CDROM 0x05 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + bool SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_SCSI_C) + static bool SCSI_Command_Inquiry(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const bool IsDataRead); + static bool SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempDataLogger.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempDataLogger.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1dc267a6fc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempDataLogger.c @@ -0,0 +1,331 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the TemperatureDataLogger project. This file contains the main tasks of + * the project and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "TempDataLogger.h" + +/** LUFA Mass Storage Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all Mass Storage Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t Disk_MS_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR, + .Size = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR, + .Size = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .TotalLUNs = 1, + }, + }; + +/** Buffer to hold the previously generated HID report, for comparison purposes inside the HID class driver. */ +static uint8_t PrevHIDReportBuffer[GENERIC_REPORT_SIZE]; + +/** LUFA HID Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all HID Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t Generic_HID_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_HID, + .ReportINEndpoint = + { + .Address = GENERIC_IN_EPADDR, + .Size = GENERIC_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .PrevReportINBuffer = PrevHIDReportBuffer, + .PrevReportINBufferSize = sizeof(PrevHIDReportBuffer), + }, + }; + +/** Non-volatile Logging Interval value in EEPROM, stored as a number of 500ms ticks */ +static uint8_t EEMEM LoggingInterval500MS_EEPROM = DEFAULT_LOG_INTERVAL; + +/** SRAM Logging Interval value fetched from EEPROM, stored as a number of 500ms ticks */ +static uint8_t LoggingInterval500MS_SRAM; + +/** Total number of 500ms logging ticks elapsed since the last log value was recorded */ +static uint16_t CurrentLoggingTicks; + +/** FAT Fs structure to hold the internal state of the FAT driver for the Dataflash contents. */ +static FATFS DiskFATState; + +/** FAT Fs structure to hold a FAT file handle for the log data write destination. */ +static FIL TempLogFile; + + +/** ISR to handle the 500ms ticks for sampling and data logging */ +ISR(TIMER1_COMPA_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + /* Signal a 500ms tick has elapsed to the RTC */ + RTC_Tick500ms(); + + /* Check to see if the logging interval has expired */ + if (++CurrentLoggingTicks < LoggingInterval500MS_SRAM) + return; + + /* Reset log tick counter to prepare for next logging interval */ + CurrentLoggingTicks = 0; + + uint8_t LEDMask = LEDs_GetLEDs(); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + + /* Only log when not connected to a USB host */ + if (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Unattached) + { + TimeDate_t CurrentTimeDate; + RTC_GetTimeDate(&CurrentTimeDate); + + char LineBuffer[100]; + uint16_t BytesWritten; + + BytesWritten = sprintf(LineBuffer, "%02d/%02d/20%02d, %02d:%02d:%02d, %d Degrees\r\n", + CurrentTimeDate.Day, CurrentTimeDate.Month, CurrentTimeDate.Year, + CurrentTimeDate.Hour, CurrentTimeDate.Minute, CurrentTimeDate.Second, + Temperature_GetTemperature()); + + f_write(&TempLogFile, LineBuffer, BytesWritten, &BytesWritten); + f_sync(&TempLogFile); + } + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask); +} + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + /* Fetch logging interval from EEPROM */ + LoggingInterval500MS_SRAM = eeprom_read_byte(&LoggingInterval500MS_EEPROM); + + /* Check if the logging interval is invalid (0xFF) indicating that the EEPROM is blank */ + if (LoggingInterval500MS_SRAM == 0xFF) + LoggingInterval500MS_SRAM = DEFAULT_LOG_INTERVAL; + + /* Mount and open the log file on the Dataflash FAT partition */ + OpenLogFile(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + MS_Device_USBTask(&Disk_MS_Interface); + HID_Device_USBTask(&Generic_HID_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Opens the log file on the Dataflash's FAT formatted partition according to the current date */ +void OpenLogFile(void) +{ + char LogFileName[12]; + + /* Get the current date for the filename as "DDMMYY.csv" */ + TimeDate_t CurrentTimeDate; + RTC_GetTimeDate(&CurrentTimeDate); + sprintf(LogFileName, "%02d%02d%02d.csv", CurrentTimeDate.Day, CurrentTimeDate.Month, CurrentTimeDate.Year); + + /* Mount the storage device, open the file */ + f_mount(0, &DiskFATState); + f_open(&TempLogFile, LogFileName, FA_OPEN_ALWAYS | FA_WRITE); + f_lseek(&TempLogFile, TempLogFile.fsize); +} + +/** Closes the open data log file on the Dataflash's FAT formatted partition */ +void CloseLogFile(void) +{ + /* Sync any data waiting to be written, unmount the storage device */ + f_sync(&TempLogFile); + f_close(&TempLogFile); +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + ADC_Init(ADC_FREE_RUNNING | ADC_PRESCALE_128); + Temperature_Init(); + Dataflash_Init(); + USB_Init(); + TWI_Init(TWI_BIT_PRESCALE_4, TWI_BITLENGTH_FROM_FREQ(4, 50000)); + RTC_Init(); + + /* 500ms logging interval timer configuration */ + OCR1A = (((F_CPU / 256) / 2) - 1); + TCCR1B = (1 << WGM12) | (1 << CS12); + TIMSK1 = (1 << OCIE1A); + + /* Check if the Dataflash is working, abort if not */ + if (!(DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation())) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); + } + + /* Clear Dataflash sector protections, if enabled */ + DataflashManager_ResetDataflashProtections(); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + /* Close the log file so that the host has exclusive file system access */ + CloseLogFile(); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + + /* Mount and open the log file on the Dataflash FAT partition */ + OpenLogFile(); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= HID_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Generic_HID_Interface); + ConfigSuccess &= MS_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Disk_MS_Interface); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + MS_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Disk_MS_Interface); + HID_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Generic_HID_Interface); +} + +/** Mass Storage class driver callback function the reception of SCSI commands from the host, which must be processed. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface configuration structure being referenced + */ +bool CALLBACK_MS_Device_SCSICommandReceived(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + bool CommandSuccess; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + CommandSuccess = SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(MSInterfaceInfo); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + + return CommandSuccess; +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the creation of HID reports to the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in,out] ReportID Report ID requested by the host if non-zero, otherwise callback should set to the generated report ID + * \param[in] ReportType Type of the report to create, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_In or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[out] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the created report should be stored + * \param[out] ReportSize Number of bytes written in the report (or zero if no report is to be sent) + * + * \return Boolean \c true to force the sending of the report, \c false to let the library determine if it needs to be sent + */ +bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize) +{ + Device_Report_t* ReportParams = (Device_Report_t*)ReportData; + + RTC_GetTimeDate(&ReportParams->TimeDate); + + ReportParams->LogInterval500MS = LoggingInterval500MS_SRAM; + + *ReportSize = sizeof(Device_Report_t); + return true; +} + +/** HID class driver callback function for the processing of HID reports from the host. + * + * \param[in] HIDInterfaceInfo Pointer to the HID class interface configuration structure being referenced + * \param[in] ReportID Report ID of the received report from the host + * \param[in] ReportType The type of report that the host has sent, either HID_REPORT_ITEM_Out or HID_REPORT_ITEM_Feature + * \param[in] ReportData Pointer to a buffer where the received report has been stored + * \param[in] ReportSize Size in bytes of the received HID report + */ +void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize) +{ + Device_Report_t* ReportParams = (Device_Report_t*)ReportData; + + RTC_SetTimeDate(&ReportParams->TimeDate); + + /* If the logging interval has changed from its current value, write it to EEPROM */ + if (LoggingInterval500MS_SRAM != ReportParams->LogInterval500MS) + { + LoggingInterval500MS_SRAM = ReportParams->LogInterval500MS; + eeprom_update_byte(&LoggingInterval500MS_EEPROM, LoggingInterval500MS_SRAM); + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempDataLogger.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempDataLogger.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..90b9b4ea63 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempDataLogger.h @@ -0,0 +1,112 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for TempDataLogger.c. + */ + +#ifndef _TEMP_DATALOGGER_H_ +#define _TEMP_DATALOGGER_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include "Lib/SCSI.h" + #include "Lib/DataflashManager.h" + #include "Lib/FATFs/ff.h" + #include "Lib/RTC.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Temperature.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/ADC.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY LEDS_LED2 + + /** Default log interval when the EEPROM is blank, in 500ms ticks. */ + #define DEFAULT_LOG_INTERVAL 10 + + /** Indicates if the disk is write protected or not. */ + #define DISK_READ_ONLY false + + /* Type Defines: */ + typedef struct + { + TimeDate_t TimeDate; + uint8_t LogInterval500MS; + } Device_Report_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void OpenLogFile(void); + void CloseLogFile(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + + bool CALLBACK_MS_Device_SCSICommandReceived(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + bool CALLBACK_HID_Device_CreateHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + uint8_t* const ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + void* ReportData, + uint16_t* const ReportSize); + void CALLBACK_HID_Device_ProcessHIDReport(USB_ClassInfo_HID_Device_t* const HIDInterfaceInfo, + const uint8_t ReportID, + const uint8_t ReportType, + const void* ReportData, + const uint16_t ReportSize); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/COPYING.LESSER.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/COPYING.LESSER.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bdf8db0eed --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/COPYING.LESSER.txt @@ -0,0 +1,166 @@ + GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE + Version 3, 29 June 2007 + + Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/> + Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies + of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. + + + This version of the GNU Lesser General Public License incorporates +the terms and conditions of version 3 of the GNU General Public +License, supplemented by the additional permissions listed below. + + 0. Additional Definitions. + + As used herein, "this License" refers to version 3 of the GNU Lesser +General Public License, and the "GNU GPL" refers to version 3 of the GNU +General Public License. + + "The Library" refers to a covered work governed by this License, +other than an Application or a Combined Work as defined below. + + An "Application" is any work that makes use of an interface provided +by the Library, but which is not otherwise based on the Library. +Defining a subclass of a class defined by the Library is deemed a mode +of using an interface provided by the Library. + + A "Combined Work" is a work produced by combining or linking an +Application with the Library. The particular version of the Library +with which the Combined Work was made is also called the "Linked +Version". + + The "Minimal Corresponding Source" for a Combined Work means the +Corresponding Source for the Combined Work, excluding any source code +for portions of the Combined Work that, considered in isolation, are +based on the Application, and not on the Linked Version. + + The "Corresponding Application Code" for a Combined Work means the +object code and/or source code for the Application, including any data +and utility programs needed for reproducing the Combined Work from the +Application, but excluding the System Libraries of the Combined Work. + + 1. Exception to Section 3 of the GNU GPL. + + You may convey a covered work under sections 3 and 4 of this License +without being bound by section 3 of the GNU GPL. + + 2. Conveying Modified Versions. + + If you modify a copy of the Library, and, in your modifications, a +facility refers to a function or data to be supplied by an Application +that uses the facility (other than as an argument passed when the +facility is invoked), then you may convey a copy of the modified +version: + + a) under this License, provided that you make a good faith effort to + ensure that, in the event an Application does not supply the + function or data, the facility still operates, and performs + whatever part of its purpose remains meaningful, or + + b) under the GNU GPL, with none of the additional permissions of + this License applicable to that copy. + + 3. Object Code Incorporating Material from Library Header Files. + + The object code form of an Application may incorporate material from +a header file that is part of the Library. You may convey such object +code under terms of your choice, provided that, if the incorporated +material is not limited to numerical parameters, data structure +layouts and accessors, or small macros, inline functions and templates +(ten or fewer lines in length), you do both of the following: + + a) Give prominent notice with each copy of the object code that the + Library is used in it and that the Library and its use are + covered by this License. + + b) Accompany the object code with a copy of the GNU GPL and this license + document. + + 4. Combined Works. + + You may convey a Combined Work under terms of your choice that, +taken together, effectively do not restrict modification of the +portions of the Library contained in the Combined Work and reverse +engineering for debugging such modifications, if you also do each of +the following: + + a) Give prominent notice with each copy of the Combined Work that + the Library is used in it and that the Library and its use are + covered by this License. + + b) Accompany the Combined Work with a copy of the GNU GPL and this license + document. + + c) For a Combined Work that displays copyright notices during + execution, include the copyright notice for the Library among + these notices, as well as a reference directing the user to the + copies of the GNU GPL and this license document. + + d) Do one of the following: + + 0) Convey the Minimal Corresponding Source under the terms of this + License, and the Corresponding Application Code in a form + suitable for, and under terms that permit, the user to + recombine or relink the Application with a modified version of + the Linked Version to produce a modified Combined Work, in the + manner specified by section 6 of the GNU GPL for conveying + Corresponding Source. + + 1) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking with the + Library. A suitable mechanism is one that (a) uses at run time + a copy of the Library already present on the user's computer + system, and (b) will operate properly with a modified version + of the Library that is interface-compatible with the Linked + Version. + + e) Provide Installation Information, but only if you would otherwise + be required to provide such information under section 6 of the + GNU GPL, and only to the extent that such information is + necessary to install and execute a modified version of the + Combined Work produced by recombining or relinking the + Application with a modified version of the Linked Version. (If + you use option 4d0, the Installation Information must accompany + the Minimal Corresponding Source and Corresponding Application + Code. If you use option 4d1, you must provide the Installation + Information in the manner specified by section 6 of the GNU GPL + for conveying Corresponding Source.) + + 5. Combined Libraries. + + You may place library facilities that are a work based on the +Library side by side in a single library together with other library +facilities that are not Applications and are not covered by this +License, and convey such a combined library under terms of your +choice, if you do both of the following: + + a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of the same work based + on the Library, uncombined with any other library facilities, + conveyed under the terms of this License. + + b) Give prominent notice with the combined library that part of it + is a work based on the Library, and explaining where to find the + accompanying uncombined form of the same work. + + 6. Revised Versions of the GNU Lesser General Public License. + + The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions +of the GNU Lesser General Public License from time to time. Such new +versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may +differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. + + Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the +Library as you received it specifies that a certain numbered version +of the GNU Lesser General Public License "or any later version" +applies to it, you have the option of following the terms and +conditions either of that published version or of any later version +published by the Free Software Foundation. If the Library as you +received it does not specify a version number of the GNU Lesser +General Public License, you may choose any version of the GNU Lesser +General Public License ever published by the Free Software Foundation. + + If the Library as you received it specifies that a proxy can decide +whether future versions of the GNU Lesser General Public License shall +apply, that proxy's public statement of acceptance of any version is +permanent authorization for you to choose that version for the +Library. + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/COPYING.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/COPYING.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..10926e87f1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/COPYING.txt @@ -0,0 +1,675 @@ + GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE + Version 3, 29 June 2007 + + Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/> + Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies + of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. + + Preamble + + The GNU General Public License is a free, copyleft license for +software and other kinds of works. + + The licenses for most software and other practical works are designed +to take away your freedom to share and change the works. By contrast, +the GNU General Public License is intended to guarantee your freedom to +share and change all versions of a program--to make sure it remains free +software for all its users. We, the Free Software Foundation, use the +GNU General Public License for most of our software; it applies also to +any other work released this way by its authors. You can apply it to +your programs, too. + + When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not +price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you +have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for +them if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you +want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new +free programs, and that you know you can do these things. + + To protect your rights, we need to prevent others from denying you +these rights or asking you to surrender the rights. Therefore, you have +certain responsibilities if you distribute copies of the software, or if +you modify it: responsibilities to respect the freedom of others. + + For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether +gratis or for a fee, you must pass on to the recipients the same +freedoms that you received. You must make sure that they, too, receive +or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so they +know their rights. + + Developers that use the GNU GPL protect your rights with two steps: +(1) assert copyright on the software, and (2) offer you this License +giving you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify it. + + For the developers' and authors' protection, the GPL clearly explains +that there is no warranty for this free software. For both users' and +authors' sake, the GPL requires that modified versions be marked as +changed, so that their problems will not be attributed erroneously to +authors of previous versions. + + Some devices are designed to deny users access to install or run +modified versions of the software inside them, although the manufacturer +can do so. This is fundamentally incompatible with the aim of +protecting users' freedom to change the software. The systematic +pattern of such abuse occurs in the area of products for individuals to +use, which is precisely where it is most unacceptable. Therefore, we +have designed this version of the GPL to prohibit the practice for those +products. If such problems arise substantially in other domains, we +stand ready to extend this provision to those domains in future versions +of the GPL, as needed to protect the freedom of users. + + Finally, every program is threatened constantly by software patents. +States should not allow patents to restrict development and use of +software on general-purpose computers, but in those that do, we wish to +avoid the special danger that patents applied to a free program could +make it effectively proprietary. To prevent this, the GPL assures that +patents cannot be used to render the program non-free. + + The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and +modification follow. + + TERMS AND CONDITIONS + + 0. Definitions. + + "This License" refers to version 3 of the GNU General Public License. + + "Copyright" also means copyright-like laws that apply to other kinds of +works, such as semiconductor masks. + + "The Program" refers to any copyrightable work licensed under this +License. Each licensee is addressed as "you". "Licensees" and +"recipients" may be individuals or organizations. + + To "modify" a work means to copy from or adapt all or part of the work +in a fashion requiring copyright permission, other than the making of an +exact copy. The resulting work is called a "modified version" of the +earlier work or a work "based on" the earlier work. + + A "covered work" means either the unmodified Program or a work based +on the Program. + + To "propagate" a work means to do anything with it that, without +permission, would make you directly or secondarily liable for +infringement under applicable copyright law, except executing it on a +computer or modifying a private copy. Propagation includes copying, +distribution (with or without modification), making available to the +public, and in some countries other activities as well. + + To "convey" a work means any kind of propagation that enables other +parties to make or receive copies. Mere interaction with a user through +a computer network, with no transfer of a copy, is not conveying. + + An interactive user interface displays "Appropriate Legal Notices" +to the extent that it includes a convenient and prominently visible +feature that (1) displays an appropriate copyright notice, and (2) +tells the user that there is no warranty for the work (except to the +extent that warranties are provided), that licensees may convey the +work under this License, and how to view a copy of this License. If +the interface presents a list of user commands or options, such as a +menu, a prominent item in the list meets this criterion. + + 1. Source Code. + + The "source code" for a work means the preferred form of the work +for making modifications to it. "Object code" means any non-source +form of a work. + + A "Standard Interface" means an interface that either is an official +standard defined by a recognized standards body, or, in the case of +interfaces specified for a particular programming language, one that +is widely used among developers working in that language. + + The "System Libraries" of an executable work include anything, other +than the work as a whole, that (a) is included in the normal form of +packaging a Major Component, but which is not part of that Major +Component, and (b) serves only to enable use of the work with that +Major Component, or to implement a Standard Interface for which an +implementation is available to the public in source code form. A +"Major Component", in this context, means a major essential component +(kernel, window system, and so on) of the specific operating system +(if any) on which the executable work runs, or a compiler used to +produce the work, or an object code interpreter used to run it. + + The "Corresponding Source" for a work in object code form means all +the source code needed to generate, install, and (for an executable +work) run the object code and to modify the work, including scripts to +control those activities. However, it does not include the work's +System Libraries, or general-purpose tools or generally available free +programs which are used unmodified in performing those activities but +which are not part of the work. For example, Corresponding Source +includes interface definition files associated with source files for +the work, and the source code for shared libraries and dynamically +linked subprograms that the work is specifically designed to require, +such as by intimate data communication or control flow between those +subprograms and other parts of the work. + + The Corresponding Source need not include anything that users +can regenerate automatically from other parts of the Corresponding +Source. + + The Corresponding Source for a work in source code form is that +same work. + + 2. Basic Permissions. + + All rights granted under this License are granted for the term of +copyright on the Program, and are irrevocable provided the stated +conditions are met. This License explicitly affirms your unlimited +permission to run the unmodified Program. The output from running a +covered work is covered by this License only if the output, given its +content, constitutes a covered work. This License acknowledges your +rights of fair use or other equivalent, as provided by copyright law. + + You may make, run and propagate covered works that you do not +convey, without conditions so long as your license otherwise remains +in force. You may convey covered works to others for the sole purpose +of having them make modifications exclusively for you, or provide you +with facilities for running those works, provided that you comply with +the terms of this License in conveying all material for which you do +not control copyright. Those thus making or running the covered works +for you must do so exclusively on your behalf, under your direction +and control, on terms that prohibit them from making any copies of +your copyrighted material outside their relationship with you. + + Conveying under any other circumstances is permitted solely under +the conditions stated below. Sublicensing is not allowed; section 10 +makes it unnecessary. + + 3. Protecting Users' Legal Rights From Anti-Circumvention Law. + + No covered work shall be deemed part of an effective technological +measure under any applicable law fulfilling obligations under article +11 of the WIPO copyright treaty adopted on 20 December 1996, or +similar laws prohibiting or restricting circumvention of such +measures. + + When you convey a covered work, you waive any legal power to forbid +circumvention of technological measures to the extent such circumvention +is effected by exercising rights under this License with respect to +the covered work, and you disclaim any intention to limit operation or +modification of the work as a means of enforcing, against the work's +users, your or third parties' legal rights to forbid circumvention of +technological measures. + + 4. Conveying Verbatim Copies. + + You may convey verbatim copies of the Program's source code as you +receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and +appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice; +keep intact all notices stating that this License and any +non-permissive terms added in accord with section 7 apply to the code; +keep intact all notices of the absence of any warranty; and give all +recipients a copy of this License along with the Program. + + You may charge any price or no price for each copy that you convey, +and you may offer support or warranty protection for a fee. + + 5. Conveying Modified Source Versions. + + You may convey a work based on the Program, or the modifications to +produce it from the Program, in the form of source code under the +terms of section 4, provided that you also meet all of these conditions: + + a) The work must carry prominent notices stating that you modified + it, and giving a relevant date. + + b) The work must carry prominent notices stating that it is + released under this License and any conditions added under section + 7. This requirement modifies the requirement in section 4 to + "keep intact all notices". + + c) You must license the entire work, as a whole, under this + License to anyone who comes into possession of a copy. This + License will therefore apply, along with any applicable section 7 + additional terms, to the whole of the work, and all its parts, + regardless of how they are packaged. This License gives no + permission to license the work in any other way, but it does not + invalidate such permission if you have separately received it. + + d) If the work has interactive user interfaces, each must display + Appropriate Legal Notices; however, if the Program has interactive + interfaces that do not display Appropriate Legal Notices, your + work need not make them do so. + + A compilation of a covered work with other separate and independent +works, which are not by their nature extensions of the covered work, +and which are not combined with it such as to form a larger program, +in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an +"aggregate" if the compilation and its resulting copyright are not +used to limit the access or legal rights of the compilation's users +beyond what the individual works permit. Inclusion of a covered work +in an aggregate does not cause this License to apply to the other +parts of the aggregate. + + 6. Conveying Non-Source Forms. + + You may convey a covered work in object code form under the terms +of sections 4 and 5, provided that you also convey the +machine-readable Corresponding Source under the terms of this License, +in one of these ways: + + a) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product + (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by the + Corresponding Source fixed on a durable physical medium + customarily used for software interchange. + + b) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product + (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by a + written offer, valid for at least three years and valid for as + long as you offer spare parts or customer support for that product + model, to give anyone who possesses the object code either (1) a + copy of the Corresponding Source for all the software in the + product that is covered by this License, on a durable physical + medium customarily used for software interchange, for a price no + more than your reasonable cost of physically performing this + conveying of source, or (2) access to copy the + Corresponding Source from a network server at no charge. + + c) Convey individual copies of the object code with a copy of the + written offer to provide the Corresponding Source. This + alternative is allowed only occasionally and noncommercially, and + only if you received the object code with such an offer, in accord + with subsection 6b. + + d) Convey the object code by offering access from a designated + place (gratis or for a charge), and offer equivalent access to the + Corresponding Source in the same way through the same place at no + further charge. You need not require recipients to copy the + Corresponding Source along with the object code. If the place to + copy the object code is a network server, the Corresponding Source + may be on a different server (operated by you or a third party) + that supports equivalent copying facilities, provided you maintain + clear directions next to the object code saying where to find the + Corresponding Source. Regardless of what server hosts the + Corresponding Source, you remain obligated to ensure that it is + available for as long as needed to satisfy these requirements. + + e) Convey the object code using peer-to-peer transmission, provided + you inform other peers where the object code and Corresponding + Source of the work are being offered to the general public at no + charge under subsection 6d. + + A separable portion of the object code, whose source code is excluded +from the Corresponding Source as a System Library, need not be +included in conveying the object code work. + + A "User Product" is either (1) a "consumer product", which means any +tangible personal property which is normally used for personal, family, +or household purposes, or (2) anything designed or sold for incorporation +into a dwelling. In determining whether a product is a consumer product, +doubtful cases shall be resolved in favor of coverage. For a particular +product received by a particular user, "normally used" refers to a +typical or common use of that class of product, regardless of the status +of the particular user or of the way in which the particular user +actually uses, or expects or is expected to use, the product. A product +is a consumer product regardless of whether the product has substantial +commercial, industrial or non-consumer uses, unless such uses represent +the only significant mode of use of the product. + + "Installation Information" for a User Product means any methods, +procedures, authorization keys, or other information required to install +and execute modified versions of a covered work in that User Product from +a modified version of its Corresponding Source. The information must +suffice to ensure that the continued functioning of the modified object +code is in no case prevented or interfered with solely because +modification has been made. + + If you convey an object code work under this section in, or with, or +specifically for use in, a User Product, and the conveying occurs as +part of a transaction in which the right of possession and use of the +User Product is transferred to the recipient in perpetuity or for a +fixed term (regardless of how the transaction is characterized), the +Corresponding Source conveyed under this section must be accompanied +by the Installation Information. But this requirement does not apply +if neither you nor any third party retains the ability to install +modified object code on the User Product (for example, the work has +been installed in ROM). + + The requirement to provide Installation Information does not include a +requirement to continue to provide support service, warranty, or updates +for a work that has been modified or installed by the recipient, or for +the User Product in which it has been modified or installed. Access to a +network may be denied when the modification itself materially and +adversely affects the operation of the network or violates the rules and +protocols for communication across the network. + + Corresponding Source conveyed, and Installation Information provided, +in accord with this section must be in a format that is publicly +documented (and with an implementation available to the public in +source code form), and must require no special password or key for +unpacking, reading or copying. + + 7. Additional Terms. + + "Additional permissions" are terms that supplement the terms of this +License by making exceptions from one or more of its conditions. +Additional permissions that are applicable to the entire Program shall +be treated as though they were included in this License, to the extent +that they are valid under applicable law. If additional permissions +apply only to part of the Program, that part may be used separately +under those permissions, but the entire Program remains governed by +this License without regard to the additional permissions. + + When you convey a copy of a covered work, you may at your option +remove any additional permissions from that copy, or from any part of +it. (Additional permissions may be written to require their own +removal in certain cases when you modify the work.) You may place +additional permissions on material, added by you to a covered work, +for which you have or can give appropriate copyright permission. + + Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, for material you +add to a covered work, you may (if authorized by the copyright holders of +that material) supplement the terms of this License with terms: + + a) Disclaiming warranty or limiting liability differently from the + terms of sections 15 and 16 of this License; or + + b) Requiring preservation of specified reasonable legal notices or + author attributions in that material or in the Appropriate Legal + Notices displayed by works containing it; or + + c) Prohibiting misrepresentation of the origin of that material, or + requiring that modified versions of such material be marked in + reasonable ways as different from the original version; or + + d) Limiting the use for publicity purposes of names of licensors or + authors of the material; or + + e) Declining to grant rights under trademark law for use of some + trade names, trademarks, or service marks; or + + f) Requiring indemnification of licensors and authors of that + material by anyone who conveys the material (or modified versions of + it) with contractual assumptions of liability to the recipient, for + any liability that these contractual assumptions directly impose on + those licensors and authors. + + All other non-permissive additional terms are considered "further +restrictions" within the meaning of section 10. If the Program as you +received it, or any part of it, contains a notice stating that it is +governed by this License along with a term that is a further +restriction, you may remove that term. If a license document contains +a further restriction but permits relicensing or conveying under this +License, you may add to a covered work material governed by the terms +of that license document, provided that the further restriction does +not survive such relicensing or conveying. + + If you add terms to a covered work in accord with this section, you +must place, in the relevant source files, a statement of the +additional terms that apply to those files, or a notice indicating +where to find the applicable terms. + + Additional terms, permissive or non-permissive, may be stated in the +form of a separately written license, or stated as exceptions; +the above requirements apply either way. + + 8. Termination. + + You may not propagate or modify a covered work except as expressly +provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to propagate or +modify it is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under +this License (including any patent licenses granted under the third +paragraph of section 11). + + However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your +license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a) +provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and +finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright +holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means +prior to 60 days after the cessation. + + Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is +reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the +violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have +received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that +copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after +your receipt of the notice. + + Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the +licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under +this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently +reinstated, you do not qualify to receive new licenses for the same +material under section 10. + + 9. Acceptance Not Required for Having Copies. + + You are not required to accept this License in order to receive or +run a copy of the Program. Ancillary propagation of a covered work +occurring solely as a consequence of using peer-to-peer transmission +to receive a copy likewise does not require acceptance. However, +nothing other than this License grants you permission to propagate or +modify any covered work. These actions infringe copyright if you do +not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or propagating a +covered work, you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so. + + 10. Automatic Licensing of Downstream Recipients. + + Each time you convey a covered work, the recipient automatically +receives a license from the original licensors, to run, modify and +propagate that work, subject to this License. You are not responsible +for enforcing compliance by third parties with this License. + + An "entity transaction" is a transaction transferring control of an +organization, or substantially all assets of one, or subdividing an +organization, or merging organizations. If propagation of a covered +work results from an entity transaction, each party to that +transaction who receives a copy of the work also receives whatever +licenses to the work the party's predecessor in interest had or could +give under the previous paragraph, plus a right to possession of the +Corresponding Source of the work from the predecessor in interest, if +the predecessor has it or can get it with reasonable efforts. + + You may not impose any further restrictions on the exercise of the +rights granted or affirmed under this License. For example, you may +not impose a license fee, royalty, or other charge for exercise of +rights granted under this License, and you may not initiate litigation +(including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that +any patent claim is infringed by making, using, selling, offering for +sale, or importing the Program or any portion of it. + + 11. Patents. + + A "contributor" is a copyright holder who authorizes use under this +License of the Program or a work on which the Program is based. The +work thus licensed is called the contributor's "contributor version". + + A contributor's "essential patent claims" are all patent claims +owned or controlled by the contributor, whether already acquired or +hereafter acquired, that would be infringed by some manner, permitted +by this License, of making, using, or selling its contributor version, +but do not include claims that would be infringed only as a +consequence of further modification of the contributor version. For +purposes of this definition, "control" includes the right to grant +patent sublicenses in a manner consistent with the requirements of +this License. + + Each contributor grants you a non-exclusive, worldwide, royalty-free +patent license under the contributor's essential patent claims, to +make, use, sell, offer for sale, import and otherwise run, modify and +propagate the contents of its contributor version. + + In the following three paragraphs, a "patent license" is any express +agreement or commitment, however denominated, not to enforce a patent +(such as an express permission to practice a patent or covenant not to +sue for patent infringement). To "grant" such a patent license to a +party means to make such an agreement or commitment not to enforce a +patent against the party. + + If you convey a covered work, knowingly relying on a patent license, +and the Corresponding Source of the work is not available for anyone +to copy, free of charge and under the terms of this License, through a +publicly available network server or other readily accessible means, +then you must either (1) cause the Corresponding Source to be so +available, or (2) arrange to deprive yourself of the benefit of the +patent license for this particular work, or (3) arrange, in a manner +consistent with the requirements of this License, to extend the patent +license to downstream recipients. "Knowingly relying" means you have +actual knowledge that, but for the patent license, your conveying the +covered work in a country, or your recipient's use of the covered work +in a country, would infringe one or more identifiable patents in that +country that you have reason to believe are valid. + + If, pursuant to or in connection with a single transaction or +arrangement, you convey, or propagate by procuring conveyance of, a +covered work, and grant a patent license to some of the parties +receiving the covered work authorizing them to use, propagate, modify +or convey a specific copy of the covered work, then the patent license +you grant is automatically extended to all recipients of the covered +work and works based on it. + + A patent license is "discriminatory" if it does not include within +the scope of its coverage, prohibits the exercise of, or is +conditioned on the non-exercise of one or more of the rights that are +specifically granted under this License. You may not convey a covered +work if you are a party to an arrangement with a third party that is +in the business of distributing software, under which you make payment +to the third party based on the extent of your activity of conveying +the work, and under which the third party grants, to any of the +parties who would receive the covered work from you, a discriminatory +patent license (a) in connection with copies of the covered work +conveyed by you (or copies made from those copies), or (b) primarily +for and in connection with specific products or compilations that +contain the covered work, unless you entered into that arrangement, +or that patent license was granted, prior to 28 March 2007. + + Nothing in this License shall be construed as excluding or limiting +any implied license or other defenses to infringement that may +otherwise be available to you under applicable patent law. + + 12. No Surrender of Others' Freedom. + + If conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or +otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not +excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot convey a +covered work so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this +License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may +not convey it at all. For example, if you agree to terms that obligate you +to collect a royalty for further conveying from those to whom you convey +the Program, the only way you could satisfy both those terms and this +License would be to refrain entirely from conveying the Program. + + 13. Use with the GNU Affero General Public License. + + Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, you have +permission to link or combine any covered work with a work licensed +under version 3 of the GNU Affero General Public License into a single +combined work, and to convey the resulting work. The terms of this +License will continue to apply to the part which is the covered work, +but the special requirements of the GNU Affero General Public License, +section 13, concerning interaction through a network will apply to the +combination as such. + + 14. Revised Versions of this License. + + The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of +the GNU General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will +be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to +address new problems or concerns. + + Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the +Program specifies that a certain numbered version of the GNU General +Public License "or any later version" applies to it, you have the +option of following the terms and conditions either of that numbered +version or of any later version published by the Free Software +Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of the +GNU General Public License, you may choose any version ever published +by the Free Software Foundation. + + If the Program specifies that a proxy can decide which future +versions of the GNU General Public License can be used, that proxy's +public statement of acceptance of a version permanently authorizes you +to choose that version for the Program. + + Later license versions may give you additional or different +permissions. However, no additional obligations are imposed on any +author or copyright holder as a result of your choosing to follow a +later version. + + 15. Disclaimer of Warranty. + + THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY +APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT +HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY +OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, +THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR +PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM +IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF +ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION. + + 16. Limitation of Liability. + + IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING +WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MODIFIES AND/OR CONVEYS +THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY +GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE +USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF +DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD +PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), +EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF +SUCH DAMAGES. + + 17. Interpretation of Sections 15 and 16. + + If the disclaimer of warranty and limitation of liability provided +above cannot be given local legal effect according to their terms, +reviewing courts shall apply local law that most closely approximates +an absolute waiver of all civil liability in connection with the +Program, unless a warranty or assumption of liability accompanies a +copy of the Program in return for a fee. + + END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS + + How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs + + If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest +possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it +free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms. + + To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest +to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively +state the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least +the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found. + + <one line to give the program's name and a brief idea of what it does.> + Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> + + This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify + it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by + the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or + (at your option) any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the + GNU General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License + along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. + +Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail. + + If the program does terminal interaction, make it output a short +notice like this when it starts in an interactive mode: + + <program> Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> + This program comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show w'. + This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it + under certain conditions; type `show c' for details. + +The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should show the appropriate +parts of the General Public License. Of course, your program's commands +might be different; for a GUI interface, you would use an "about box". + + You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or school, +if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the program, if necessary. +For more information on this, and how to apply and follow the GNU GPL, see +<http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. + + The GNU General Public License does not permit incorporating your program +into proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you +may consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with +the library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General +Public License instead of this License. But first, please read +<http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/why-not-lgpl.html>. + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/DataLoggerSettings.Designer.cs b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/DataLoggerSettings.Designer.cs new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..58fac51449 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/DataLoggerSettings.Designer.cs @@ -0,0 +1,181 @@ +namespace Project1HostApp +{ + partial class frmDataloggerSettings + { + /// <summary> + /// Required designer variable. + /// </summary> + private System.ComponentModel.IContainer components = null; + + /// <summary> + /// Clean up any resources being used. + /// </summary> + /// <param name="disposing">true if managed resources should be disposed; otherwise, false.</param> + protected override void Dispose(bool disposing) + { + if (disposing && (components != null)) + { + components.Dispose(); + } + base.Dispose(disposing); + } + + #region Windows Form Designer generated code + + /// <summary> + /// Required method for Designer support - do not modify + /// the contents of this method with the code editor. + /// </summary> + private void InitializeComponent() + { + this.btnSetValues = new System.Windows.Forms.Button(); + this.dtpTime = new System.Windows.Forms.DateTimePicker(); + this.lblTime = new System.Windows.Forms.Label(); + this.lblLoggingInterval = new System.Windows.Forms.Label(); + this.nudLogInterval = new System.Windows.Forms.NumericUpDown(); + this.lblSeconds = new System.Windows.Forms.Label(); + this.btnGetValues = new System.Windows.Forms.Button(); + this.lblDate = new System.Windows.Forms.Label(); + this.dtpDate = new System.Windows.Forms.DateTimePicker(); + ((System.ComponentModel.ISupportInitialize)(this.nudLogInterval)).BeginInit(); + this.SuspendLayout(); + // + // btnSetValues + // + this.btnSetValues.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(168, 136); + this.btnSetValues.Name = "btnSetValues"; + this.btnSetValues.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(90, 35); + this.btnSetValues.TabIndex = 0; + this.btnSetValues.Text = "Set Values"; + this.btnSetValues.UseVisualStyleBackColor = true; + this.btnSetValues.Click += new System.EventHandler(this.btnSetValues_Click); + // + // dtpTime + // + this.dtpTime.CustomFormat = ""; + this.dtpTime.Format = System.Windows.Forms.DateTimePickerFormat.Time; + this.dtpTime.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(148, 61); + this.dtpTime.Name = "dtpTime"; + this.dtpTime.ShowUpDown = true; + this.dtpTime.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(110, 20); + this.dtpTime.TabIndex = 1; + // + // lblTime + // + this.lblTime.AutoSize = true; + this.lblTime.Font = new System.Drawing.Font("Microsoft Sans Serif", 8.25F, System.Drawing.FontStyle.Bold, System.Drawing.GraphicsUnit.Point, ((byte)(0))); + this.lblTime.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(51, 67); + this.lblTime.Name = "lblTime"; + this.lblTime.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(82, 13); + this.lblTime.TabIndex = 2; + this.lblTime.Text = "Device Time:"; + // + // lblLoggingInterval + // + this.lblLoggingInterval.AutoSize = true; + this.lblLoggingInterval.Font = new System.Drawing.Font("Microsoft Sans Serif", 8.25F, System.Drawing.FontStyle.Bold, System.Drawing.GraphicsUnit.Point, ((byte)(0))); + this.lblLoggingInterval.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(30, 101); + this.lblLoggingInterval.Name = "lblLoggingInterval"; + this.lblLoggingInterval.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(103, 13); + this.lblLoggingInterval.TabIndex = 3; + this.lblLoggingInterval.Text = "Logging Interval:"; + // + // nudLogInterval + // + this.nudLogInterval.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(148, 94); + this.nudLogInterval.Maximum = new decimal(new int[] { + 60, + 0, + 0, + 0}); + this.nudLogInterval.Minimum = new decimal(new int[] { + 1, + 0, + 0, + 0}); + this.nudLogInterval.Name = "nudLogInterval"; + this.nudLogInterval.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(51, 20); + this.nudLogInterval.TabIndex = 5; + this.nudLogInterval.Value = new decimal(new int[] { + 5, + 0, + 0, + 0}); + // + // lblSeconds + // + this.lblSeconds.AutoSize = true; + this.lblSeconds.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(209, 101); + this.lblSeconds.Name = "lblSeconds"; + this.lblSeconds.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(49, 13); + this.lblSeconds.TabIndex = 6; + this.lblSeconds.Text = "Seconds"; + // + // btnGetValues + // + this.btnGetValues.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(30, 136); + this.btnGetValues.Name = "btnGetValues"; + this.btnGetValues.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(90, 35); + this.btnGetValues.TabIndex = 7; + this.btnGetValues.Text = "Get Values"; + this.btnGetValues.UseVisualStyleBackColor = true; + this.btnGetValues.Click += new System.EventHandler(this.btnGetValues_Click); + // + // lblDate + // + this.lblDate.AutoSize = true; + this.lblDate.Font = new System.Drawing.Font("Microsoft Sans Serif", 8.25F, System.Drawing.FontStyle.Bold, System.Drawing.GraphicsUnit.Point, ((byte)(0))); + this.lblDate.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(51, 33); + this.lblDate.Name = "lblDate"; + this.lblDate.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(82, 13); + this.lblDate.TabIndex = 8; + this.lblDate.Text = "Device Date:"; + // + // dtpDate + // + this.dtpDate.CustomFormat = "dd/MM/yyyy"; + this.dtpDate.Format = System.Windows.Forms.DateTimePickerFormat.Custom; + this.dtpDate.Location = new System.Drawing.Point(148, 27); + this.dtpDate.Name = "dtpDate"; + this.dtpDate.Size = new System.Drawing.Size(110, 20); + this.dtpDate.TabIndex = 9; + // + // frmDataloggerSettings + // + this.AutoScaleDimensions = new System.Drawing.SizeF(6F, 13F); + this.AutoScaleMode = System.Windows.Forms.AutoScaleMode.Font; + this.ClientSize = new System.Drawing.Size(300, 197); + this.Controls.Add(this.dtpDate); + this.Controls.Add(this.lblDate); + this.Controls.Add(this.btnGetValues); + this.Controls.Add(this.lblSeconds); + this.Controls.Add(this.nudLogInterval); + this.Controls.Add(this.lblLoggingInterval); + this.Controls.Add(this.lblTime); + this.Controls.Add(this.dtpTime); + this.Controls.Add(this.btnSetValues); + this.MaximizeBox = false; + this.MinimizeBox = false; + this.Name = "frmDataloggerSettings"; + this.Text = "Datalogger"; + this.Load += new System.EventHandler(this.frmDataloggerSettings_Load); + ((System.ComponentModel.ISupportInitialize)(this.nudLogInterval)).EndInit(); + this.ResumeLayout(false); + this.PerformLayout(); + + } + + #endregion + + private System.Windows.Forms.Button btnSetValues; + private System.Windows.Forms.DateTimePicker dtpTime; + private System.Windows.Forms.Label lblTime; + private System.Windows.Forms.Label lblLoggingInterval; + private System.Windows.Forms.NumericUpDown nudLogInterval; + private System.Windows.Forms.Label lblSeconds; + private System.Windows.Forms.Button btnGetValues; + private System.Windows.Forms.Label lblDate; + private System.Windows.Forms.DateTimePicker dtpDate; + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/DataLoggerSettings.cs b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/DataLoggerSettings.cs new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c3d1e15645 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/DataLoggerSettings.cs @@ -0,0 +1,179 @@ +using System; +using System.Collections.Generic; +using System.ComponentModel; +using System.Data; +using System.Drawing; +using System.Linq; +using System.Text; +using System.Windows.Forms; +using Hid; + +namespace Project1HostApp +{ + public partial class frmDataloggerSettings : Form + { + private const int DEVICE_VID = 0x03EB; + private const int DEVICE_PID = 0x2063; + + private struct Device_Report_t + { + public Byte Day; + public Byte Month; + public Byte Year; + + public Byte Hour; + public Byte Minute; + public Byte Second; + + public Byte LogInterval500MS; + + public Byte[] ToReport() + { + Byte[] Report = new Byte[7]; + + Report[0] = this.Hour; + Report[1] = this.Minute; + Report[2] = this.Second; + Report[3] = this.Day; + Report[4] = this.Month; + Report[5] = this.Year; + Report[6] = this.LogInterval500MS; + + return Report; + } + + public void FromReport(Byte[] Report) + { + this.Hour = Report[0]; + this.Minute = Report[1]; + this.Second = Report[2]; + this.Day = Report[3]; + this.Month = Report[4]; + this.Year = Report[5]; + this.LogInterval500MS = Report[6]; + } + }; + + private IDevice GetDeviceConnection() + { + IDevice[] ConnectedDevices = DeviceFactory.Enumerate(DEVICE_VID, DEVICE_PID); + IDevice ConnectionHandle = null; + + if (ConnectedDevices.Count() > 0) + ConnectionHandle = ConnectedDevices[0]; + else + return null; + + // Fix report handle under Windows + if (ConnectionHandle is Hid.Win32.Win32DeviceSet) + { + ((Hid.Win32.Win32DeviceSet)ConnectionHandle).AddDevice(0x00, + ((Hid.Win32.Win32DeviceSet)ConnectionHandle).UnallocatedDevices[0]); + } + + return ConnectionHandle; + } + + public frmDataloggerSettings() + { + InitializeComponent(); + } + + private void btnSetValues_Click(object sender, EventArgs e) + { + IDevice ConnectionHandle = GetDeviceConnection(); + + if (ConnectionHandle == null) + { + MessageBox.Show("Error: Cannot connect to Datalogger device."); + return; + } + + Device_Report_t DeviceReport = new Device_Report_t(); + DeviceReport.Day = (byte)dtpDate.Value.Day; + DeviceReport.Month = (byte)dtpDate.Value.Month; + DeviceReport.Year = (byte)((dtpDate.Value.Year < 2000) ? 0 : (dtpDate.Value.Year - 2000)); + DeviceReport.Hour = (byte)dtpTime.Value.Hour; + DeviceReport.Minute = (byte)dtpTime.Value.Minute; + DeviceReport.Second = (byte)dtpTime.Value.Second; + DeviceReport.LogInterval500MS = (byte)(nudLogInterval.Value * 2); + + try + { + ConnectionHandle.Write(0x00, DeviceReport.ToReport()); + MessageBox.Show("Device parameters updated successfully."); + } + catch (Exception ex) + { + MessageBox.Show("Error: " + ex.Message); + } + } + + private void btnGetValues_Click(object sender, EventArgs e) + { + IDevice ConnectionHandle = GetDeviceConnection(); + + if (ConnectionHandle == null) + { + MessageBox.Show("Error: Cannot connect to Datalogger device."); + return; + } + + Device_Report_t DeviceReport = new Device_Report_t(); + + try + { + Byte[] Report = new Byte[7]; + + ConnectionHandle.Read(0x00, Report); + DeviceReport.FromReport(Report); + String msgText = "Device parameters retrieved successfully."; + + try + { + dtpDate.Value = new DateTime( + (2000 + DeviceReport.Year), + DeviceReport.Month, + DeviceReport.Day); + + dtpTime.Value = new DateTime( + DateTime.Now.Year, DateTime.Now.Month, DateTime.Now.Day, + DeviceReport.Hour, + DeviceReport.Minute, + DeviceReport.Second); + } + catch (Exception ex) + { + msgText = "Problem reading device:\n" + + ex.Message + + "\nY:" + DeviceReport.Year.ToString() + + " M:" + DeviceReport.Month.ToString() + + " D:" + DeviceReport.Day.ToString() + + "\n\nUsing current date and time."; + dtpDate.Value = DateTime.Now; + dtpTime.Value = DateTime.Now; + } + + try + { + nudLogInterval.Value = (DeviceReport.LogInterval500MS / 2); + } + catch (Exception ex) + { + nudLogInterval.Value = nudLogInterval.Minimum; + } + + MessageBox.Show(msgText); + } + catch (Exception ex) + { + MessageBox.Show("Error: " + ex.Message); + } + } + + private void frmDataloggerSettings_Load(object sender, EventArgs e) + { + + } + } +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/DataLoggerSettings.resx b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/DataLoggerSettings.resx new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..19dc0dd8b3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/DataLoggerSettings.resx @@ -0,0 +1,120 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?> +<root> + <!-- + Microsoft ResX Schema + + Version 2.0 + + The primary goals of this format is to allow a simple XML format + that is mostly human readable. The generation and parsing of the + various data types are done through the TypeConverter classes + associated with the data types. + + Example: + + ... ado.net/XML headers & schema ... + <resheader name="resmimetype">text/microsoft-resx</resheader> + <resheader name="version">2.0</resheader> + <resheader name="reader">System.Resources.ResXResourceReader, System.Windows.Forms, ...</resheader> + <resheader name="writer">System.Resources.ResXResourceWriter, System.Windows.Forms, ...</resheader> + <data name="Name1"><value>this is my long string</value><comment>this is a comment</comment></data> + <data name="Color1" type="System.Drawing.Color, System.Drawing">Blue</data> + <data name="Bitmap1" mimetype="application/x-microsoft.net.object.binary.base64"> + <value>[base64 mime encoded serialized .NET Framework object]</value> + </data> + <data name="Icon1" type="System.Drawing.Icon, System.Drawing" mimetype="application/x-microsoft.net.object.bytearray.base64"> + <value>[base64 mime encoded string representing a byte array form of the .NET Framework object]</value> + <comment>This is a comment</comment> + </data> + + There are any number of "resheader" rows that contain simple + name/value pairs. + + Each data row contains a name, and value. The row also contains a + type or mimetype. Type corresponds to a .NET class that support + text/value conversion through the TypeConverter architecture. + Classes that don't support this are serialized and stored with the + mimetype set. + + The mimetype is used for serialized objects, and tells the + ResXResourceReader how to depersist the object. This is currently not + extensible. For a given mimetype the value must be set accordingly: + + Note - application/x-microsoft.net.object.binary.base64 is the format + that the ResXResourceWriter will generate, however the reader can + read any of the formats listed below. + + mimetype: application/x-microsoft.net.object.binary.base64 + value : The object must be serialized with + : System.Runtime.Serialization.Formatters.Binary.BinaryFormatter + : and then encoded with base64 encoding. + + mimetype: application/x-microsoft.net.object.soap.base64 + value : The object must be serialized with + : System.Runtime.Serialization.Formatters.Soap.SoapFormatter + : and then encoded with base64 encoding. + + mimetype: application/x-microsoft.net.object.bytearray.base64 + value : The object must be serialized into a byte array + : using a System.ComponentModel.TypeConverter + : and then encoded with base64 encoding. + --> + <xsd:schema id="root" xmlns="" xmlns:xsd="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema" xmlns:msdata="urn:schemas-microsoft-com:xml-msdata"> + <xsd:import namespace="http://www.w3.org/XML/1998/namespace" /> + <xsd:element name="root" msdata:IsDataSet="true"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:choice maxOccurs="unbounded"> + <xsd:element name="metadata"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:sequence> + <xsd:element name="value" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" /> + </xsd:sequence> + <xsd:attribute name="name" use="required" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute name="type" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute name="mimetype" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute ref="xml:space" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + <xsd:element name="assembly"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:attribute name="alias" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + <xsd:element name="data"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:sequence> + <xsd:element name="value" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" msdata:Ordinal="1" /> + <xsd:element name="comment" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" msdata:Ordinal="2" /> + </xsd:sequence> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" use="required" msdata:Ordinal="1" /> + <xsd:attribute name="type" type="xsd:string" msdata:Ordinal="3" /> + <xsd:attribute name="mimetype" type="xsd:string" msdata:Ordinal="4" /> + <xsd:attribute ref="xml:space" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + <xsd:element name="resheader"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:sequence> + <xsd:element name="value" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" msdata:Ordinal="1" /> + </xsd:sequence> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" use="required" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + </xsd:choice> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + </xsd:schema> + <resheader name="resmimetype"> + <value>text/microsoft-resx</value> + </resheader> + <resheader name="version"> + <value>2.0</value> + </resheader> + <resheader name="reader"> + <value>System.Resources.ResXResourceReader, System.Windows.Forms, Version=2.0.0.0, Culture=neutral, PublicKeyToken=b77a5c561934e089</value> + </resheader> + <resheader name="writer"> + <value>System.Resources.ResXResourceWriter, System.Windows.Forms, Version=2.0.0.0, Culture=neutral, PublicKeyToken=b77a5c561934e089</value> + </resheader> +</root>
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Hid.Linux.dll b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Hid.Linux.dll Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4c19edd212 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Hid.Linux.dll diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Hid.Net.dll b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Hid.Net.dll Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2a7112fc09 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Hid.Net.dll diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Hid.Win32.dll b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Hid.Win32.dll Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3693c6ca04 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Hid.Win32.dll diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Program.cs b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Program.cs new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2588e60c14 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Program.cs @@ -0,0 +1,21 @@ +using System; +using System.Collections.Generic; +using System.Linq; +using System.Windows.Forms; + +namespace Project1HostApp +{ + static class Program + { + /// <summary> + /// The main entry point for the application. + /// </summary> + [STAThread] + static void Main() + { + Application.EnableVisualStyles(); + Application.SetCompatibleTextRenderingDefault(false); + Application.Run(new frmDataloggerSettings()); + } + } +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Properties/AssemblyInfo.cs b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Properties/AssemblyInfo.cs new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a4d0ab1d5f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Properties/AssemblyInfo.cs @@ -0,0 +1,36 @@ +using System.Reflection; +using System.Runtime.CompilerServices; +using System.Runtime.InteropServices; + +// General Information about an assembly is controlled through the following +// set of attributes. Change these attribute values to modify the information +// associated with an assembly. +[assembly: AssemblyTitle("TempDataLoggerHostApp")] +[assembly: AssemblyDescription("")] +[assembly: AssemblyConfiguration("")] +[assembly: AssemblyCompany("Dean Camera")] +[assembly: AssemblyProduct("Temp Datalogger HostApp")] +[assembly: AssemblyCopyright("Copyright © Dean Camera 2011")] +[assembly: AssemblyTrademark("")] +[assembly: AssemblyCulture("")] + +// Setting ComVisible to false makes the types in this assembly not visible +// to COM components. If you need to access a type in this assembly from +// COM, set the ComVisible attribute to true on that type. +[assembly: ComVisible(false)] + +// The following GUID is for the ID of the typelib if this project is exposed to COM +[assembly: Guid("f41d67c7-13b2-4710-9e0f-f78e7f2bf2e9")] + +// Version information for an assembly consists of the following four values: +// +// Major Version +// Minor Version +// Build Number +// Revision +// +// You can specify all the values or you can default the Build and Revision Numbers +// by using the '*' as shown below: +// [assembly: AssemblyVersion("1.0.*")] +[assembly: AssemblyVersion("1.0.0.0")] +[assembly: AssemblyFileVersion("1.0.0.0")] diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Properties/Resources.Designer.cs b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Properties/Resources.Designer.cs new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..63b1af40d2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Properties/Resources.Designer.cs @@ -0,0 +1,63 @@ +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +// <auto-generated> +// This code was generated by a tool. +// Runtime Version:4.0.30319.239 +// +// Changes to this file may cause incorrect behavior and will be lost if +// the code is regenerated. +// </auto-generated> +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------ + +namespace TemperatureLoggerHostApp.Properties { + using System; + + + /// <summary> + /// A strongly-typed resource class, for looking up localized strings, etc. + /// </summary> + // This class was auto-generated by the StronglyTypedResourceBuilder + // class via a tool like ResGen or Visual Studio. + // To add or remove a member, edit your .ResX file then rerun ResGen + // with the /str option, or rebuild your VS project. + [global::System.CodeDom.Compiler.GeneratedCodeAttribute("System.Resources.Tools.StronglyTypedResourceBuilder", "4.0.0.0")] + [global::System.Diagnostics.DebuggerNonUserCodeAttribute()] + [global::System.Runtime.CompilerServices.CompilerGeneratedAttribute()] + internal class Resources { + + private static global::System.Resources.ResourceManager resourceMan; + + private static global::System.Globalization.CultureInfo resourceCulture; + + [global::System.Diagnostics.CodeAnalysis.SuppressMessageAttribute("Microsoft.Performance", "CA1811:AvoidUncalledPrivateCode")] + internal Resources() { + } + + /// <summary> + /// Returns the cached ResourceManager instance used by this class. + /// </summary> + [global::System.ComponentModel.EditorBrowsableAttribute(global::System.ComponentModel.EditorBrowsableState.Advanced)] + internal static global::System.Resources.ResourceManager ResourceManager { + get { + if (object.ReferenceEquals(resourceMan, null)) { + global::System.Resources.ResourceManager temp = new global::System.Resources.ResourceManager("TemperatureLoggerHostApp.Properties.Resources", typeof(Resources).Assembly); + resourceMan = temp; + } + return resourceMan; + } + } + + /// <summary> + /// Overrides the current thread's CurrentUICulture property for all + /// resource lookups using this strongly typed resource class. + /// </summary> + [global::System.ComponentModel.EditorBrowsableAttribute(global::System.ComponentModel.EditorBrowsableState.Advanced)] + internal static global::System.Globalization.CultureInfo Culture { + get { + return resourceCulture; + } + set { + resourceCulture = value; + } + } + } +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Properties/Resources.resx b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Properties/Resources.resx new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..af7dbebbac --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Properties/Resources.resx @@ -0,0 +1,117 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?> +<root> + <!-- + Microsoft ResX Schema + + Version 2.0 + + The primary goals of this format is to allow a simple XML format + that is mostly human readable. The generation and parsing of the + various data types are done through the TypeConverter classes + associated with the data types. + + Example: + + ... ado.net/XML headers & schema ... + <resheader name="resmimetype">text/microsoft-resx</resheader> + <resheader name="version">2.0</resheader> + <resheader name="reader">System.Resources.ResXResourceReader, System.Windows.Forms, ...</resheader> + <resheader name="writer">System.Resources.ResXResourceWriter, System.Windows.Forms, ...</resheader> + <data name="Name1"><value>this is my long string</value><comment>this is a comment</comment></data> + <data name="Color1" type="System.Drawing.Color, System.Drawing">Blue</data> + <data name="Bitmap1" mimetype="application/x-microsoft.net.object.binary.base64"> + <value>[base64 mime encoded serialized .NET Framework object]</value> + </data> + <data name="Icon1" type="System.Drawing.Icon, System.Drawing" mimetype="application/x-microsoft.net.object.bytearray.base64"> + <value>[base64 mime encoded string representing a byte array form of the .NET Framework object]</value> + <comment>This is a comment</comment> + </data> + + There are any number of "resheader" rows that contain simple + name/value pairs. + + Each data row contains a name, and value. The row also contains a + type or mimetype. Type corresponds to a .NET class that support + text/value conversion through the TypeConverter architecture. + Classes that don't support this are serialized and stored with the + mimetype set. + + The mimetype is used for serialized objects, and tells the + ResXResourceReader how to depersist the object. This is currently not + extensible. For a given mimetype the value must be set accordingly: + + Note - application/x-microsoft.net.object.binary.base64 is the format + that the ResXResourceWriter will generate, however the reader can + read any of the formats listed below. + + mimetype: application/x-microsoft.net.object.binary.base64 + value : The object must be serialized with + : System.Serialization.Formatters.Binary.BinaryFormatter + : and then encoded with base64 encoding. + + mimetype: application/x-microsoft.net.object.soap.base64 + value : The object must be serialized with + : System.Runtime.Serialization.Formatters.Soap.SoapFormatter + : and then encoded with base64 encoding. + + mimetype: application/x-microsoft.net.object.bytearray.base64 + value : The object must be serialized into a byte array + : using a System.ComponentModel.TypeConverter + : and then encoded with base64 encoding. + --> + <xsd:schema id="root" xmlns="" xmlns:xsd="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema" xmlns:msdata="urn:schemas-microsoft-com:xml-msdata"> + <xsd:element name="root" msdata:IsDataSet="true"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:choice maxOccurs="unbounded"> + <xsd:element name="metadata"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:sequence> + <xsd:element name="value" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" /> + </xsd:sequence> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute name="type" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute name="mimetype" type="xsd:string" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + <xsd:element name="assembly"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:attribute name="alias" type="xsd:string" /> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + <xsd:element name="data"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:sequence> + <xsd:element name="value" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" msdata:Ordinal="1" /> + <xsd:element name="comment" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" msdata:Ordinal="2" /> + </xsd:sequence> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" msdata:Ordinal="1" /> + <xsd:attribute name="type" type="xsd:string" msdata:Ordinal="3" /> + <xsd:attribute name="mimetype" type="xsd:string" msdata:Ordinal="4" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + <xsd:element name="resheader"> + <xsd:complexType> + <xsd:sequence> + <xsd:element name="value" type="xsd:string" minOccurs="0" msdata:Ordinal="1" /> + </xsd:sequence> + <xsd:attribute name="name" type="xsd:string" use="required" /> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + </xsd:choice> + </xsd:complexType> + </xsd:element> + </xsd:schema> + <resheader name="resmimetype"> + <value>text/microsoft-resx</value> + </resheader> + <resheader name="version"> + <value>2.0</value> + </resheader> + <resheader name="reader"> + <value>System.Resources.ResXResourceReader, System.Windows.Forms, Version=2.0.0.0, Culture=neutral, PublicKeyToken=b77a5c561934e089</value> + </resheader> + <resheader name="writer"> + <value>System.Resources.ResXResourceWriter, System.Windows.Forms, Version=2.0.0.0, Culture=neutral, PublicKeyToken=b77a5c561934e089</value> + </resheader> +</root>
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Properties/Settings.Designer.cs b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Properties/Settings.Designer.cs new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..95fc3ad588 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Properties/Settings.Designer.cs @@ -0,0 +1,26 @@ +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +// <auto-generated> +// This code was generated by a tool. +// Runtime Version:4.0.30319.239 +// +// Changes to this file may cause incorrect behavior and will be lost if +// the code is regenerated. +// </auto-generated> +//------------------------------------------------------------------------------ + +namespace TemperatureLoggerHostApp.Properties { + + + [global::System.Runtime.CompilerServices.CompilerGeneratedAttribute()] + [global::System.CodeDom.Compiler.GeneratedCodeAttribute("Microsoft.VisualStudio.Editors.SettingsDesigner.SettingsSingleFileGenerator", "10.0.0.0")] + internal sealed partial class Settings : global::System.Configuration.ApplicationSettingsBase { + + private static Settings defaultInstance = ((Settings)(global::System.Configuration.ApplicationSettingsBase.Synchronized(new Settings()))); + + public static Settings Default { + get { + return defaultInstance; + } + } + } +} diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Properties/Settings.settings b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Properties/Settings.settings new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..39645652af --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/Properties/Settings.settings @@ -0,0 +1,7 @@ +<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?> +<SettingsFile xmlns="http://schemas.microsoft.com/VisualStudio/2004/01/settings" CurrentProfile="(Default)"> + <Profiles> + <Profile Name="(Default)" /> + </Profiles> + <Settings /> +</SettingsFile> diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/README.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/README.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ab6b9a83a7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/README.txt @@ -0,0 +1,24 @@ +http://en.sourceforge.jp/projects/sfnet_libhidnet/ + +This library has been tested on Windows Vista 32bit, Windows Vista 64bit, +Windows XP 32bit and Debian (Lenny) AMD64 but should work on any version of +Windows that can run the .NET framework 2.0 and any other operating system +that has both hiddev and Mono. + +Any additions must be tested and work on Windows and Linux, on both 32 and +64 bit. Windows 64 bit testing is particularly important as it is often +neglected. + + +Hid.Linux.dll was compiled under Linux with Mono (mcs) and uses no generics. + +Hid.Win32.dll and Hid.Net.dll were compiled under Windows with the .NET +Framework v2.0.50727 but are also tested to compile with Mono (gmcs). + + +A good starting point when using this library is Hid.DeviceFactory's Enumerate +methods. + +LogitechMX5000.cs is a simple example of how the library can be used. Other +examples on common devices are welcomed. + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/TempLoggerHostApp.csproj b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/TempLoggerHostApp.csproj new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8517d6f42a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp/TempLoggerHostApp.csproj @@ -0,0 +1,99 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?> +<Project ToolsVersion="4.0" DefaultTargets="Build" xmlns="http://schemas.microsoft.com/developer/msbuild/2003"> + <PropertyGroup> + <Configuration Condition=" '$(Configuration)' == '' ">Debug</Configuration> + <Platform Condition=" '$(Platform)' == '' ">AnyCPU</Platform> + <ProductVersion>9.0.21022</ProductVersion> + <SchemaVersion>2.0</SchemaVersion> + <ProjectGuid>{A2D66069-8CF9-4104-828C-49A73D7DB5D1}</ProjectGuid> + <OutputType>WinExe</OutputType> + <AppDesignerFolder>Properties</AppDesignerFolder> + <RootNamespace>TemperatureLoggerHostApp</RootNamespace> + <AssemblyName>TemperatureLoggerHostApp</AssemblyName> + <TargetFrameworkVersion>v3.5</TargetFrameworkVersion> + <FileAlignment>512</FileAlignment> + <FileUpgradeFlags> + </FileUpgradeFlags> + <OldToolsVersion>3.5</OldToolsVersion> + <UpgradeBackupLocation /> + </PropertyGroup> + <PropertyGroup Condition=" '$(Configuration)|$(Platform)' == 'Debug|AnyCPU' "> + <DebugSymbols>true</DebugSymbols> + <DebugType>full</DebugType> + <Optimize>false</Optimize> + <OutputPath>bin\Debug\</OutputPath> + <DefineConstants>DEBUG;TRACE</DefineConstants> + <ErrorReport>prompt</ErrorReport> + <WarningLevel>4</WarningLevel> + </PropertyGroup> + <PropertyGroup Condition=" '$(Configuration)|$(Platform)' == 'Release|AnyCPU' "> + <DebugType>pdbonly</DebugType> + <Optimize>true</Optimize> + <OutputPath>bin\Release\</OutputPath> + <DefineConstants>TRACE</DefineConstants> + <ErrorReport>prompt</ErrorReport> + <WarningLevel>4</WarningLevel> + </PropertyGroup> + <ItemGroup> + <Reference Include="Hid.Net, Version=1.0.0.0, Culture=neutral, processorArchitecture=MSIL"> + <SpecificVersion>False</SpecificVersion> + <HintPath>.\Hid.Net.dll</HintPath> + </Reference> + <Reference Include="System" /> + <Reference Include="System.Core"> + <RequiredTargetFramework>3.5</RequiredTargetFramework> + </Reference> + <Reference Include="System.Xml.Linq"> + <RequiredTargetFramework>3.5</RequiredTargetFramework> + </Reference> + <Reference Include="System.Data.DataSetExtensions"> + <RequiredTargetFramework>3.5</RequiredTargetFramework> + </Reference> + <Reference Include="System.Data" /> + <Reference Include="System.Deployment" /> + <Reference Include="System.Drawing" /> + <Reference Include="System.Windows.Forms" /> + <Reference Include="System.Xml" /> + </ItemGroup> + <ItemGroup> + <Compile Include="DataLoggerSettings.cs"> + <SubType>Form</SubType> + </Compile> + <Compile Include="DataLoggerSettings.Designer.cs"> + <DependentUpon>DataLoggerSettings.cs</DependentUpon> + </Compile> + <Compile Include="Program.cs" /> + <Compile Include="Properties\AssemblyInfo.cs" /> + <EmbeddedResource Include="DataLoggerSettings.resx"> + <DependentUpon>DataLoggerSettings.cs</DependentUpon> + <SubType>Designer</SubType> + </EmbeddedResource> + <EmbeddedResource Include="Properties\Resources.resx"> + <Generator>ResXFileCodeGenerator</Generator> + <LastGenOutput>Resources.Designer.cs</LastGenOutput> + <SubType>Designer</SubType> + </EmbeddedResource> + <Compile Include="Properties\Resources.Designer.cs"> + <AutoGen>True</AutoGen> + <DependentUpon>Resources.resx</DependentUpon> + <DesignTime>True</DesignTime> + </Compile> + <None Include="Properties\Settings.settings"> + <Generator>SettingsSingleFileGenerator</Generator> + <LastGenOutput>Settings.Designer.cs</LastGenOutput> + </None> + <Compile Include="Properties\Settings.Designer.cs"> + <AutoGen>True</AutoGen> + <DependentUpon>Settings.settings</DependentUpon> + <DesignTimeSharedInput>True</DesignTimeSharedInput> + </Compile> + </ItemGroup> + <Import Project="$(MSBuildToolsPath)\Microsoft.CSharp.targets" /> + <!-- To modify your build process, add your task inside one of the targets below and uncomment it. + Other similar extension points exist, see Microsoft.Common.targets. + <Target Name="BeforeBuild"> + </Target> + <Target Name="AfterBuild"> + </Target> + --> +</Project>
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp_Python/temp_log_config.py b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp_Python/temp_log_config.py new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fdb4ad9b69 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TempLogHostApp_Python/temp_log_config.py @@ -0,0 +1,99 @@ +""" + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +""" + +""" + Front-end configuration app for the TempDataLogger project. This script + configures the logger to the current system time and date, with a user + defined logging interval. + + The logging interval should be specified in milliseconds and is rounded to + a multiple of 500ms. + + Usage: + python temp_log_config.py <Log_Interval> + + Example: + python temp_log_config.py 500 + + Requires the pywinusb library (https://pypi.python.org/pypi/pywinusb/). +""" + +import sys +from datetime import datetime +import pywinusb.hid as hid + +# Generic HID device VID, PID and report payload length (length is increased +# by one to account for the Report ID byte that must be pre-pended) +device_vid = 0x03EB +device_pid = 0x2063 +report_length = 1 + 7 + + +def get_hid_device_handle(): + hid_device_filter = hid.HidDeviceFilter(vendor_id=device_vid, + product_id=device_pid) + + valid_hid_devices = hid_device_filter.get_devices() + + if len(valid_hid_devices) is 0: + return None + else: + return valid_hid_devices[0] + + +def configure_temp_log_device(device, time_date, log_interval_500ms): + # Report data for the demo is the report ID (always zero) + report_data = [0] + + # Followed by the time/date data + report_data.extend([time_date.hour, time_date.minute, + time_date.second, time_date.day, + time_date.month, time_date.year - 2000]) + + # Lastly the log interval in 500ms units of time + report_data.extend([log_interval_500ms]) + + # Zero-extend the array to the length the report should be + report_data.extend([0] * (report_length - len(report_data))) + + # Send the generated report to the device + device.send_output_report(report_data) + + +def main(time_date, log_interval_500ms): + hid_device = get_hid_device_handle() + + if hid_device is None: + print("No valid HID device found.") + sys.exit(1) + + try: + hid_device.open() + + print("Connected to device 0x%04X/0x%04X - %s [%s]" % + (hid_device.vendor_id, hid_device.product_id, + hid_device.product_name, hid_device.vendor_name)) + + configure_temp_log_device(hid_device, time_date, log_interval_500ms) + + print("Time/Date is now set to %s" % time_date) + print("Log interval is now set to every %0.1fs" % (log_interval_500ms * (500.0 / 1000.0))) + + finally: + hid_device.close() + + +if __name__ == '__main__': + time_date = datetime.now() + log_interval_500ms = (int(sys.argv[1]) / 500) if len(sys.argv) > 1 else 2 + + # Clamp the log interval to the allowable range + log_interval_500ms = max(log_interval_500ms, 0x01) + log_interval_500ms = min(log_interval_500ms, 0xFF) + + main(time_date, log_interval_500ms) diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TemperatureDataLogger.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TemperatureDataLogger.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4d4e0b5e84 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/TemperatureDataLogger.txt @@ -0,0 +1,86 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage Temperature Datalogger Project + * + * \section Sec_Compat Demo Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this demo. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) - <i>those with >16KB of FLASH memory only</i> + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this demo. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Classes:</b></td> + * <td>Mass Storage Device \n + * Human Interface Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclasses:</b></td> + * <td>Bulk-Only Transport \n + * Keyboard Subclass</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF Mass Storage Standard \n + * USB Bulk-Only Transport Standard \n + * SCSI Primary Commands Specification \n + * SCSI Block Commands Specification \n + * USBIF HID Specification, USBIF HID Usage Tables</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Temperature Data Logger project. This project is a very basic USB data logger for the current temperature as reported by + * the board's temperature sensor, writing the temperature to a file stored on the board's Dataflash in a FAT filesystem + * each time a specified interval elapses. When inserted into a PC, the datalogger will appear as a standard USB Mass Storage + * device with a single text file, which contains the logged data. Files are named according to the current date when the + * logging commences. + * + * A DS1307 or compatible RTC IC is designed to be attached to the AVR's TWI bus, for the management of timestamps on the + * sampled data. This project will not function correctly if the RTC chip is omitted unless the DUMMY_RTC compile time token + * is specified - see \ref Sec_Options. + * + * Due to the host's need for exclusive access to the file system, the device will not log samples while connected to a host. + * For the logger to store data, the Dataflash must first be formatted by the host so that it contains a valid FAT file system. + * + * This project uses the FatFS library from ELM Chan (http://elm-chan.org/fsw/ff/00index_e.html) and the .NET HID device library + * LibHIDNet (http://sourceforge.net/projects/libhidnet/). + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this demo, which can control the demo behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>DUMMY_RTC</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When a DS1307 RTC chip is not fitted, this token can be defined to make the demo use a dummy software RTC using the system + * clock. This is less accurate and does not store the set time and date into non-volatile memory.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ca08c55b4c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,72 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0"> + <project caption="Temperature Datalogger" id="lufa.projects.temp_datalogger.avr8"> + <require idref="lufa.projects.temp_datalogger"/> + <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> + <generator value="as5_8"/> + + <device-support value="at90usb1287"/> + <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="usbkey"/> + + <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="8000000UL"/> + <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="8000000UL"/> + </project> + + <module type="application" id="lufa.projects.temp_datalogger" caption="Temperature Datalogger"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Temperature Datalogger project. + </info> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/> + + <info type="keyword" value="Technology"> + <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/> + <keyword value="USB Device"/> + <keyword value="HID Class"/> + <keyword value="Mass Storage Class"/> + </info> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/> + <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="TemperatureDataLogger.txt"/> + <build type="distribute" subtype="directory" value="TempLogHostApp"/> + <build type="distribute" subtype="directory" value="TempLogHostApp_Python"/> + + <build type="c-source" value="TempDataLogger.c"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="TempDataLogger.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/> + + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/DataflashManager.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/DataflashManager.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/RTC.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/RTC.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/SCSI.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/SCSI.h"/> + + <build type="include-path" value="Lib/FATFs/"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/FATFs/ff.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/FATFs/ff.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/FATFs/diskio.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/FATFs/diskio.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/FATFs/ffconf.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/FATFs/integer.h"/> + + <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/> + <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/> + + <require idref="lufa.common"/> + <require idref="lufa.platform"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.temperature"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.dataflash"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.adc"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.twi"/> + </module> +</asf> diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3959841744 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2397 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "Temperature Datalogger Project" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ \ + TempLogHostApp/ \ + TempLogHostApp_Python/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/makefile b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fea6fea91d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/TempDataLogger/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,44 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = TempDataLogger +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c Lib/DataflashManager.c Lib/RTC.c Lib/SCSI.c Lib/FATFs/diskio.c Lib/FATFs/ff.c \ + $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) $(LUFA_SRC_SERIAL) $(LUFA_SRC_TWI) $(LUFA_SRC_TEMPERATURE) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f7d7e62708 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 + #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..982703707f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,245 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x204B, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED), + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .CDC_CCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Header = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .CDCSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + }, + + .CDC_Functional_ACM = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ACM, + + .Capabilities = 0x06, + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Union = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Union, + + .MasterInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .SlaveInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + }, + + .CDC_NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0xFF + }, + + .CDC_DCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .CDC_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA USB-RS232 Adapter"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b19682a2b6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,110 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 2) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_TX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define CDC_RX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE 8 + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC data IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE 16 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // CDC Command Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_CCI_Interface; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t CDC_Functional_Header; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t CDC_Functional_ACM; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t CDC_Functional_Union; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_NotificationEndpoint; + + // CDC Data Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_DCI_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataOutEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataInEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI = 0, /**< CDC CCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI = 1, /**< CDC DCI interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/LUFA USBtoSerial.inf b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/LUFA USBtoSerial.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b00fab6a44 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/LUFA USBtoSerial.inf @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +;************************************************************ +; Windows USB CDC ACM Setup File +; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation +;************************************************************ + +[DefaultInstall] +CopyINF="LUFA USBtoSerial.inf" + +[Version] +Signature="$Windows NT$" +Class=Ports +ClassGuid={4D36E978-E325-11CE-BFC1-08002BE10318} +Provider=%MFGNAME% +DriverVer=7/1/2012,10.0.0.0 + +[Manufacturer] +%MFGNAME%=DeviceList, NTx86, NTamd64, NTia64 + +[SourceDisksNames] + +[SourceDisksFiles] + +[DestinationDirs] +DefaultDestDir=12 + +[DriverInstall] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +CopyFiles=FakeModemCopyFileSection +AddReg=DriverInstall.AddReg + +[DriverInstall.Services] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +AddService=usbser, 0x00000002, LowerFilter_Service_Inst + +[DriverInstall.AddReg] +HKR,,EnumPropPages32,,"msports.dll,SerialPortPropPageProvider" + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; Vendor and Product ID Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; When developing your USB device, the VID and PID used in the PC side +; application program and the firmware on the microcontroller must match. +; Modify the below line to use your VID and PID. Use the format as shown below. +; Note: One INF file can be used for multiple devices with different VID and PIDs. +; For each supported device, append ",USB\VID_xxxx&PID_yyyy" to the end of the line. +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[DeviceList] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204B + +[DeviceList.NTx86] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204B + +[DeviceList.NTamd64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204B + +[DeviceList.NTia64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204B + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; String Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +;Modify these strings to customize your device +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[Strings] +MFGNAME="http://www.lufa-lib.org" +DESCRIPTION="LUFA USB to Serial"
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/USBtoSerial.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/USBtoSerial.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..47a84a4ada --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/USBtoSerial.c @@ -0,0 +1,254 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the USBtoSerial project. This file contains the main tasks of + * the project and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "USBtoSerial.h" + +/** Circular buffer to hold data from the host before it is sent to the device via the serial port. */ +static RingBuffer_t USBtoUSART_Buffer; + +/** Underlying data buffer for \ref USBtoUSART_Buffer, where the stored bytes are located. */ +static uint8_t USBtoUSART_Buffer_Data[128]; + +/** Circular buffer to hold data from the serial port before it is sent to the host. */ +static RingBuffer_t USARTtoUSB_Buffer; + +/** Underlying data buffer for \ref USARTtoUSB_Buffer, where the stored bytes are located. */ +static uint8_t USARTtoUSB_Buffer_Data[128]; + +/** LUFA CDC Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all CDC Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .ControlInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + }, + }; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + RingBuffer_InitBuffer(&USBtoUSART_Buffer, USBtoUSART_Buffer_Data, sizeof(USBtoUSART_Buffer_Data)); + RingBuffer_InitBuffer(&USARTtoUSB_Buffer, USARTtoUSB_Buffer_Data, sizeof(USARTtoUSB_Buffer_Data)); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + /* Only try to read in bytes from the CDC interface if the transmit buffer is not full */ + if (!(RingBuffer_IsFull(&USBtoUSART_Buffer))) + { + int16_t ReceivedByte = CDC_Device_ReceiveByte(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + + /* Store received byte into the USART transmit buffer */ + if (!(ReceivedByte < 0)) + RingBuffer_Insert(&USBtoUSART_Buffer, ReceivedByte); + } + + uint16_t BufferCount = RingBuffer_GetCount(&USARTtoUSB_Buffer); + if (BufferCount) + { + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface.Config.DataINEndpoint.Address); + + /* Check if a packet is already enqueued to the host - if so, we shouldn't try to send more data + * until it completes as there is a chance nothing is listening and a lengthy timeout could occur */ + if (Endpoint_IsINReady()) + { + /* Never send more than one bank size less one byte to the host at a time, so that we don't block + * while a Zero Length Packet (ZLP) to terminate the transfer is sent if the host isn't listening */ + uint8_t BytesToSend = MIN(BufferCount, (CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE - 1)); + + /* Read bytes from the USART receive buffer into the USB IN endpoint */ + while (BytesToSend--) + { + /* Try to send the next byte of data to the host, abort if there is an error without dequeuing */ + if (CDC_Device_SendByte(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface, + RingBuffer_Peek(&USARTtoUSB_Buffer)) != ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError) + { + break; + } + + /* Dequeue the already sent byte from the buffer now we have confirmed that no transmission error occurred */ + RingBuffer_Remove(&USARTtoUSB_Buffer); + } + } + } + + /* Load the next byte from the USART transmit buffer into the USART if transmit buffer space is available */ + if (Serial_IsSendReady() && !(RingBuffer_IsEmpty(&USBtoUSART_Buffer))) + Serial_SendByte(RingBuffer_Remove(&USBtoUSART_Buffer)); + + CDC_Device_USBTask(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= CDC_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + CDC_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); +} + +/** ISR to manage the reception of data from the serial port, placing received bytes into a circular buffer + * for later transmission to the host. + */ +ISR(USART1_RX_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + uint8_t ReceivedByte = UDR1; + + if ((USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Configured) && !(RingBuffer_IsFull(&USARTtoUSB_Buffer))) + RingBuffer_Insert(&USARTtoUSB_Buffer, ReceivedByte); +} + +/** Event handler for the CDC Class driver Line Encoding Changed event. + * + * \param[in] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to the CDC class interface configuration structure being referenced + */ +void EVENT_CDC_Device_LineEncodingChanged(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint8_t ConfigMask = 0; + + switch (CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.ParityType) + { + case CDC_PARITY_Odd: + ConfigMask = ((1 << UPM11) | (1 << UPM10)); + break; + case CDC_PARITY_Even: + ConfigMask = (1 << UPM11); + break; + } + + if (CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.CharFormat == CDC_LINEENCODING_TwoStopBits) + ConfigMask |= (1 << USBS1); + + switch (CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.DataBits) + { + case 6: + ConfigMask |= (1 << UCSZ10); + break; + case 7: + ConfigMask |= (1 << UCSZ11); + break; + case 8: + ConfigMask |= ((1 << UCSZ11) | (1 << UCSZ10)); + break; + } + + /* Keep the TX line held high (idle) while the USART is reconfigured */ + PORTD |= (1 << 3); + + /* Must turn off USART before reconfiguring it, otherwise incorrect operation may occur */ + UCSR1B = 0; + UCSR1A = 0; + UCSR1C = 0; + + /* Set the new baud rate before configuring the USART */ + UBRR1 = SERIAL_2X_UBBRVAL(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.BaudRateBPS); + + /* Reconfigure the USART in double speed mode for a wider baud rate range at the expense of accuracy */ + UCSR1C = ConfigMask; + UCSR1A = (1 << U2X1); + UCSR1B = ((1 << RXCIE1) | (1 << TXEN1) | (1 << RXEN1)); + + /* Release the TX line after the USART has been reconfigured */ + PORTD &= ~(1 << 3); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/USBtoSerial.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/USBtoSerial.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ed6880baf0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/USBtoSerial.h @@ -0,0 +1,77 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for USBtoSerial.c. + */ + +#ifndef _USB_SERIAL_H_ +#define _USB_SERIAL_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + + #include "Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/Serial.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/RingBuffer.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + + void EVENT_CDC_Device_LineEncodingChanged(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/USBtoSerial.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/USBtoSerial.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0620f93938 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/USBtoSerial.txt @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage USB to Serial Converter Project + * + * \section Sec_Compat Project Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this project. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * \li Series 6 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx6) + * \li Series 4 USB AVRs (ATMEGAxxU4) + * \li Series 2 USB AVRs (AT90USBxx2, ATMEGAxxU2) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this project. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Abstract Control Model (ACM)</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>USBIF CDC Class Standard</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * USB to Serial bridge project. This project allows a USB AVR to serve + * as a USB to USART bridge between a USB host and a device lacking a + * USB port. When programmed into a USB AVR, the AVR will enumerate as a + * virtual COM port. + * + * The AVR's hardware USART's settings will change to mirror as closely as + * possible the serial settings set on the host. However, due to hardware + * limitations, some options may not be supported (baud rates with unacceptable + * error rates at the AVR's clock speed, data lengths other than 6, 7 or 8 bits, + * 1.5 stop bits, parity other than none, even or odd). + * + * After running this project for the first time on a new computer, + * you will need to supply the .INF file located in this project + * project's directory as the device's driver when running under + * Windows. This will enable Windows to use its inbuilt CDC drivers, + * negating the need for custom drivers for the device. Other + * Operating Systems should automatically use their own inbuilt + * CDC-ACM drivers. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this project, which can control the project behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td> + * None + * </td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..13f9ba8fb1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,51 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0"> + <project caption="USB to Serial Converter" id="lufa.projects.usb_to_serial.avr8"> + <require idref="lufa.projects.usb_to_serial"/> + <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> + <generator value="as5_8"/> + + <device-support value="at90usb1287"/> + <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="usbkey"/> + + <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="8000000UL"/> + <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="8000000UL"/> + </project> + + <module type="application" id="lufa.projects.usb_to_serial" caption="USB to Serial Converter"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + USB to Serial USART converter project. + </info> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/> + + <info type="keyword" value="Technology"> + <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/> + <keyword value="USB Device"/> + <keyword value="CDC Class"/> + </info> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/> + <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="USBtoSerial.txt"/> + <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="LUFA USBtoSerial.inf"/> + + <build type="c-source" value="USBtoSerial.c"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="USBtoSerial.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/> + + <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/> + + <require idref="lufa.common"/> + <require idref="lufa.platform"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.usart"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ringbuffer"/> + </module> +</asf> diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4f79dc6bc0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - USB to Serial Device Project" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/makefile b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b39042ff31 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/USBtoSerial/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = USBtoSerial +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..30a265767c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,73 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define ENABLE_DHCP_CLIENT + #define ENABLE_DHCP_SERVER + #define ENABLE_TELNET_SERVER + #define MAX_URI_LENGTH 50 + + #define DEVICE_IP_ADDRESS (uint8_t[]){ 10, 0, 0, 2} + #define DEVICE_NETMASK (uint8_t[]){255, 255, 255, 0} + #define DEVICE_GATEWAY (uint8_t[]){ 10, 0, 0, 1} + #define SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS (uint8_t[]){ 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0} + + #define UIP_CONF_UDP (defined(ENABLE_DHCP_CLIENT) || defined(ENABLE_DHCP_SERVER)) + #define UIP_CONF_BROADCAST 1 + #define UIP_CONF_TCP 1 + #define UIP_CONF_UDP_CONNS 1 + #define UIP_CONF_MAX_CONNECTIONS 3 + #define UIP_CONF_MAX_LISTENPORTS 5 + #define UIP_CONF_BUFFER_SIZE 1514 + #define UIP_CONF_LL_802154 0 + #define UIP_CONF_LL_80211 0 + #define UIP_CONF_ROUTER 0 + #define UIP_CONF_ICMP6 0 + #define UIP_CONF_ICMP_DEST_UNREACH 1 + #define UIP_URGDATA 0 + #define UIP_ARCH_CHKSUM 0 + #define UIP_ARCH_ADD32 0 + #define UIP_NEIGHBOR_CONF_ADDRTYPE 0 + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ba602dbad6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) +// #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT +// #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 8 + #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE + #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT +// #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP +// #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Descriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Descriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..72dda9f124 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Descriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,295 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "Descriptors.h" + + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = USB_CSCP_IADDeviceClass, + .SubClass = USB_CSCP_IADDeviceSubclass, + .Protocol = USB_CSCP_IADDeviceProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x2069, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 3, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED, + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .CDC_IAD = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_Association_t), .Type = DTYPE_InterfaceAssociation}, + + .FirstInterfaceIndex = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_VendorSpecificProtocol, + + .IADStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_CCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_VendorSpecificProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Header = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .CDCSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + }, + + .CDC_Functional_ACM = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ACM, + + .Capabilities = 0x00, + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Union = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Union, + + .MasterInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .SlaveInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + }, + + .CDC_NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0xFF + }, + + .CDC_DCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .RNDIS_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .RNDIS_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .MS_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = MS_CSCP_MassStorageClass, + .SubClass = MS_CSCP_SCSITransparentSubclass, + .Protocol = MS_CSCP_BulkOnlyTransportProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .MS_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .MS_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA Webserver"); + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Descriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Descriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..66da1b654c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Descriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,128 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Descriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the Mass Storage device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the Mass Storage host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) + + /** Size in bytes of the Mass Storage data endpoints. */ + #define MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE 64 + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 5) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_TX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 1) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define CDC_RX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 2) + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE 8 + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC data IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE 64 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // RNDIS CDC Command Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_Association_t CDC_IAD; + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_CCI_Interface; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t CDC_Functional_Header; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t CDC_Functional_ACM; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t CDC_Functional_Union; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_NotificationEndpoint; + + // RNDIS CDC Data Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_DCI_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t RNDIS_DataOutEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t RNDIS_DataInEndpoint; + + // Mass Storage Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t MS_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t MS_DataInEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t MS_DataOutEndpoint; + } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI = 0, /**< CDC CCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI = 1, /**< CDC DCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage = 2, /**< Mass storage interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum StringDescriptors_t + { + STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/LUFA Webserver RNDIS.inf b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/LUFA Webserver RNDIS.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c77de8f6bb --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/LUFA Webserver RNDIS.inf @@ -0,0 +1,59 @@ +; Windows LUFA RNDIS Setup File +; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation + +[DefaultInstall] +CopyINF="LUFA Webserver RNDIS.inf" + +[Version] +Signature="$Windows NT$" +Class=Net +ClassGuid={4d36e972-e325-11ce-bfc1-08002be10318} +Provider=%MFGNAME% +DriverVer=7/1/2012,10.0.0.0 + +[Manufacturer] +%MFGNAME%=DeviceList, NTx86, NTamd64, NTia64 + +[ControlFlags] +ExcludeFromSelect=* + +[DriverInstall] +Characteristics=0x84 ; NCF_PHYSICAL + NCF_HAS_UI +BusType=15 +include=netrndis.inf +needs=Usb_Rndis.ndi +AddReg=Rndis_AddReg_Vista + +[DriverInstall.Services] +include=netrndis.inf +needs=Usb_Rndis.ndi.Services + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; Vendor and Product ID Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; When developing your USB device, the VID and PID used in the PC side +; application program and the firmware on the microcontroller must match. +; Modify the below line to use your VID and PID. Use the format as shown below. +; Note: One INF file can be used for multiple devices with different VID and PIDs. +; For each supported device, append ",USB\VID_xxxx&PID_yyyy" to the end of the line. +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[DeviceList] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2069 + +[DeviceList.NTx86] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2069 + +[DeviceList.NTamd64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2069 + +[DeviceList.NTia64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_2069 + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; String Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +;Modify these strings to customize your device +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[Strings] +MFGNAME="http://www.lufa-lib.org" +DESCRIPTION="LUFA USB RNDIS Demo" diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPClientApp.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPClientApp.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..760718127e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPClientApp.c @@ -0,0 +1,208 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * DHCP Client Application. When connected to the uIP stack, this will retrieve IP configuration settings from the + * DHCP server on the network. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_DHCPCLIENTAPP_C +#include "DHCPClientApp.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_DHCP_CLIENT) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + +/** Initialization function for the DHCP client. */ +void DHCPClientApp_Init(void) +{ + /* Create a new UDP connection to the DHCP server port for the DHCP solicitation */ + struct uip_udp_conn* Connection = uip_udp_new(&uip_broadcast_addr, HTONS(DHCP_SERVER_PORT)); + + /* If the connection was successfully created, bind it to the local DHCP client port */ + if (Connection != NULL) + { + uip_udp_appstate_t* const AppState = &Connection->appstate; + uip_udp_bind(Connection, HTONS(DHCP_CLIENT_PORT)); + + /* Set the initial client state */ + AppState->DHCPClient.CurrentState = DHCP_STATE_SendDiscover; + + /* Set timeout period to half a second for a DHCP server to respond */ + timer_set(&AppState->DHCPClient.Timeout, CLOCK_SECOND / 2); + } +} + +/** uIP stack application callback for the DHCP client. This function must be called each time the TCP/IP stack + * needs a UDP packet to be processed. + */ +void DHCPClientApp_Callback(void) +{ + uip_udp_appstate_t* const AppState = &uip_udp_conn->appstate; + DHCP_Header_t* const AppData = (DHCP_Header_t*)uip_appdata; + uint16_t AppDataSize = 0; + + switch (AppState->DHCPClient.CurrentState) + { + case DHCP_STATE_SendDiscover: + /* Clear all DHCP settings, reset client IP address */ + memset(&AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data, 0x00, sizeof(AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data)); + uip_sethostaddr((uip_ipaddr_t*)&AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.AllocatedIP); + + /* Fill out the DHCP response header */ + AppDataSize += DHCPClientApp_FillDHCPHeader(AppData, DHCP_DISCOVER, AppState); + + /* Add the required DHCP options list to the packet */ + uint8_t RequiredOptionList[] = {DHCP_OPTION_SUBNET_MASK, DHCP_OPTION_ROUTER, DHCP_OPTION_DNS_SERVER}; + AppDataSize += DHCPCommon_SetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_REQ_LIST, sizeof(RequiredOptionList), + RequiredOptionList); + + /* Send the DHCP DISCOVER packet */ + uip_udp_send(AppDataSize); + + /* Reset the timeout timer, progress to next state */ + timer_reset(&AppState->DHCPClient.Timeout); + AppState->DHCPClient.CurrentState = DHCP_STATE_WaitForOffer; + + break; + case DHCP_STATE_WaitForOffer: + if (!(uip_newdata())) + { + /* Check if the DHCP timeout period has expired while waiting for a response */ + if (timer_expired(&AppState->DHCPClient.Timeout)) + AppState->DHCPClient.CurrentState = DHCP_STATE_SendDiscover; + + break; + } + + uint8_t OfferResponse_MessageType; + if ((AppData->TransactionID == DHCP_TRANSACTION_ID) && + DHCPCommon_GetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_MSG_TYPE, &OfferResponse_MessageType) && + (OfferResponse_MessageType == DHCP_OFFER)) + { + /* Received a DHCP offer for an IP address, copy over values for later request */ + memcpy(&AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.AllocatedIP, &AppData->YourIP, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); + DHCPCommon_GetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_SUBNET_MASK, &AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.Netmask); + DHCPCommon_GetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_ROUTER, &AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.GatewayIP); + DHCPCommon_GetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_SERVER_ID, &AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.ServerIP); + + timer_reset(&AppState->DHCPClient.Timeout); + AppState->DHCPClient.CurrentState = DHCP_STATE_SendRequest; + } + + break; + case DHCP_STATE_SendRequest: + /* Fill out the DHCP response header */ + AppDataSize += DHCPClientApp_FillDHCPHeader(AppData, DHCP_REQUEST, AppState); + + /* Add the DHCP REQUESTED IP ADDRESS option to the packet */ + AppDataSize += DHCPCommon_SetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_REQ_IPADDR, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t), + &AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.AllocatedIP); + + /* Add the DHCP SERVER IP ADDRESS option to the packet */ + AppDataSize += DHCPCommon_SetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_SERVER_ID, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t), + &AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.ServerIP); + + /* Send the DHCP REQUEST packet */ + uip_udp_send(AppDataSize); + + /* Reset the timeout timer, progress to next state */ + timer_reset(&AppState->DHCPClient.Timeout); + AppState->DHCPClient.CurrentState = DHCP_STATE_WaitForACK; + + break; + case DHCP_STATE_WaitForACK: + if (!(uip_newdata())) + { + /* Check if the DHCP timeout period has expired while waiting for a response */ + if (timer_expired(&AppState->DHCPClient.Timeout)) + AppState->DHCPClient.CurrentState = DHCP_STATE_SendDiscover; + + break; + } + + uint8_t RequestResponse_MessageType; + if ((AppData->TransactionID == DHCP_TRANSACTION_ID) && + DHCPCommon_GetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_MSG_TYPE, &RequestResponse_MessageType) && + (RequestResponse_MessageType == DHCP_ACK)) + { + /* Set the new network parameters from the DHCP server */ + uip_sethostaddr((uip_ipaddr_t*)&AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.AllocatedIP); + uip_setnetmask((uip_ipaddr_t*)&AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.Netmask); + uip_setdraddr((uip_ipaddr_t*)&AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.GatewayIP); + + AppState->DHCPClient.CurrentState = DHCP_STATE_AddressLeased; + } + + break; + } +} + +/** Fills the DHCP packet response with the appropriate BOOTP header for DHCP. This fills out all the required + * fields, leaving only the additional DHCP options to be added to the packet before it is sent to the DHCP server. + * + * \param[out] DHCPHeader Location in the packet buffer where the BOOTP header should be written to + * \param[in] DHCPMessageType DHCP Message type, such as DHCP_DISCOVER + * \param[in] AppState Application state of the current UDP connection + * + * \return Size in bytes of the created DHCP packet + */ +static uint16_t DHCPClientApp_FillDHCPHeader(DHCP_Header_t* const DHCPHeader, + const uint8_t DHCPMessageType, + uip_udp_appstate_t* const AppState) +{ + /* Erase existing packet data so that we start will all 0x00 DHCP header data */ + memset(DHCPHeader, 0, sizeof(DHCP_Header_t)); + + /* Fill out the DHCP packet header */ + DHCPHeader->Operation = DHCP_OP_BOOTREQUEST; + DHCPHeader->HardwareType = DHCP_HTYPE_ETHERNET; + DHCPHeader->HardwareAddressLength = sizeof(MACAddress); + DHCPHeader->Hops = 0; + DHCPHeader->TransactionID = DHCP_TRANSACTION_ID; + DHCPHeader->ElapsedSeconds = 0; + DHCPHeader->Flags = HTONS(BOOTP_BROADCAST); + memcpy(&DHCPHeader->ClientIP, &uip_hostaddr, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); + memcpy(&DHCPHeader->YourIP, &AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.AllocatedIP, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); + memcpy(&DHCPHeader->NextServerIP, &AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.ServerIP, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); + memcpy(&DHCPHeader->ClientHardwareAddress, &MACAddress, sizeof(struct uip_eth_addr)); + DHCPHeader->Cookie = DHCP_MAGIC_COOKIE; + + /* Add a DHCP message type and terminator options to the start of the DHCP options field */ + DHCPHeader->Options[0] = DHCP_OPTION_MSG_TYPE; + DHCPHeader->Options[1] = 1; + DHCPHeader->Options[2] = DHCPMessageType; + DHCPHeader->Options[3] = DHCP_OPTION_END; + + /* Calculate the total number of bytes added to the outgoing packet */ + return (sizeof(DHCP_Header_t) + 4); +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPClientApp.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPClientApp.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0aec00331c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPClientApp.h @@ -0,0 +1,69 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for DHCPClientApp.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DHCPCLIENT_APP_H_ +#define _DHCPCLIENT_APP_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <uip.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + #include "../Webserver.h" + #include "DHCPCommon.h" + + /* Enums: */ + /** States for each DHCP connection to a DHCP client. */ + enum DHCP_Client_States_t + { + DHCP_STATE_SendDiscover, /**< Send DISCOVER packet to retrieve DHCP lease offers */ + DHCP_STATE_WaitForOffer, /**< Waiting for OFFER packet giving available DHCP leases */ + DHCP_STATE_SendRequest, /**< Send REQUEST packet to request a DHCP lease */ + DHCP_STATE_WaitForACK, /**< Wait for ACK packet to complete the DHCP lease */ + DHCP_STATE_AddressLeased, /**< DHCP address has been leased from a DHCP server */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void DHCPClientApp_Init(void); + void DHCPClientApp_Callback(void); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_DHCPCLIENTAPP_C) + static uint16_t DHCPClientApp_FillDHCPHeader(DHCP_Header_t* const DHCPHeader, + const uint8_t DHCPMessageType, + uip_udp_appstate_t* const AppState); + #endif +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPCommon.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPCommon.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6d80f65cae --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPCommon.c @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Common DHCP routines to manage DHCP packet data. + */ + +#include "DHCPCommon.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_DHCP_CLIENT) || defined(ENABLE_DHCP_SERVER) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + +/** Sets the given DHCP option in the DHCP packet's option list. This automatically moves the + * end of options terminator past the new option in the options list. + * + * \param[in,out] DHCPOptionList Pointer to the start of the DHCP packet's options list + * \param[in] Option DHCP option to add to the list + * \param[in] DataLen Size in bytes of the option data to add + * \param[in] OptionData Buffer where the option's data is to be sourced from + * + * \return Number of bytes added to the DHCP packet + */ +uint8_t DHCPCommon_SetOption(uint8_t* DHCPOptionList, + const uint8_t Option, + const uint8_t DataLen, + void* const OptionData) +{ + /* Skip through the DHCP options list until the terminator option is found */ + while (*DHCPOptionList != DHCP_OPTION_END) + DHCPOptionList += (DHCPOptionList[1] + 2); + + /* Overwrite the existing terminator with the new option, add a new terminator at the end of the list */ + DHCPOptionList[0] = Option; + DHCPOptionList[1] = DataLen; + memcpy(&DHCPOptionList[2], OptionData, DataLen); + DHCPOptionList[2 + DataLen] = DHCP_OPTION_END; + + /* Calculate the total number of bytes added to the outgoing packet */ + return (2 + DataLen); +} + +/** Retrieves the given option's data (if present) from the DHCP packet's options list. + * + * \param[in,out] DHCPOptionList Pointer to the start of the DHCP packet's options list + * \param[in] Option DHCP option to retrieve to the list + * \param[out] Destination Buffer where the option's data is to be written to if found + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the option was found in the DHCP packet's options list, \c false otherwise + */ +bool DHCPCommon_GetOption(const uint8_t* DHCPOptionList, + const uint8_t Option, + void* const Destination) +{ + /* Look through the incoming DHCP packet's options list for the requested option */ + while (*DHCPOptionList != DHCP_OPTION_END) + { + /* Check if the current DHCP option in the packet is the one requested */ + if (DHCPOptionList[0] == Option) + { + /* Copy request option's data to the destination buffer */ + memcpy(Destination, &DHCPOptionList[2], DHCPOptionList[1]); + + /* Indicate that the requested option data was successfully retrieved */ + return true; + } + + /* Skip to next DHCP option in the options list */ + DHCPOptionList += (DHCPOptionList[1] + 2); + } + + /* Requested option not found in the incoming packet's DHCP options list */ + return false; +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPCommon.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPCommon.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8f54c16717 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPCommon.h @@ -0,0 +1,159 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for common DHCP defines. + */ + +#ifndef _DHCP_COMMON_H_ +#define _DHCP_COMMON_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <stdint.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <uip.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** UDP listen port for a BOOTP server. */ + #define DHCP_SERVER_PORT 67 + + /** UDP listen port for a BOOTP client. */ + #define DHCP_CLIENT_PORT 68 + + /** BOOTP message type for a BOOTP REQUEST message. */ + #define DHCP_OP_BOOTREQUEST 0x01 + + /** BOOTP message type for a BOOTP REPLY message. */ + #define DHCP_OP_BOOTREPLY 0x02 + + /** BOOTP flag for a BOOTP broadcast message. */ + #define BOOTP_BROADCAST 0x8000 + + /** Magic DHCP cookie for a BOOTP message to identify it as a DHCP message. */ + #define DHCP_MAGIC_COOKIE 0x63538263 + + /** Unique transaction ID used to identify DHCP responses to the client. */ + #define DHCP_TRANSACTION_ID 0x13245466 + + /** DHCP message type for a DISCOVER message. */ + #define DHCP_DISCOVER 1 + + /** DHCP message type for an OFFER message. */ + #define DHCP_OFFER 2 + + /** DHCP message type for a REQUEST message. */ + #define DHCP_REQUEST 3 + + /** DHCP message type for a DECLINE message. */ + #define DHCP_DECLINE 4 + + /** DHCP message type for an ACK message. */ + #define DHCP_ACK 5 + + /** DHCP message type for a NAK message. */ + #define DHCP_NAK 6 + + /** DHCP message type for a RELEASE message. */ + #define DHCP_RELEASE 7 + + /** DHCP medium type for standard Ethernet. */ + #define DHCP_HTYPE_ETHERNET 1 + + /** DHCP message option for the network subnet mask. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_SUBNET_MASK 1 + + /** DHCP message option for the network gateway IP. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_ROUTER 3 + + /** DHCP message option for the network DNS server. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_DNS_SERVER 6 + + /** DHCP message option for the requested client IP address. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_REQ_IPADDR 50 + + /** DHCP message option for the IP address lease time. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_LEASE_TIME 51 + + /** DHCP message option for the DHCP message type. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_MSG_TYPE 53 + + /** DHCP message option for the DHCP server IP. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_SERVER_ID 54 + + /** DHCP message option for the list of required options from the server. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_REQ_LIST 55 + + /** DHCP message option for the options list terminator. */ + #define DHCP_OPTION_END 255 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a DHCP packet inside an Ethernet frame. */ + typedef struct + { + uint8_t Operation; /**< DHCP operation, either DHCP_OP_BOOTREQUEST or DHCP_OP_BOOTREPLY */ + uint8_t HardwareType; /**< Hardware carrier type constant */ + uint8_t HardwareAddressLength; /**< Length in bytes of a hardware (MAC) address on the network */ + uint8_t Hops; /**< Number of hops required to reach the server, unused */ + + uint32_t TransactionID; /**< Unique ID of the DHCP packet, for positive matching between sent and received packets */ + + uint16_t ElapsedSeconds; /**< Elapsed seconds since the request was made */ + uint16_t Flags; /**< BOOTP packet flags */ + + uip_ipaddr_t ClientIP; /**< Client IP address, if already leased an IP */ + uip_ipaddr_t YourIP; /**< Client IP address */ + uip_ipaddr_t NextServerIP; /**< Legacy BOOTP protocol field, unused for DHCP */ + uip_ipaddr_t RelayAgentIP; /**< Legacy BOOTP protocol field, unused for DHCP */ + + uint8_t ClientHardwareAddress[16]; /**< Hardware (MAC) address of the client making a request to the DHCP server */ + uint8_t ServerHostnameString[64]; /**< Legacy BOOTP protocol field, unused for DHCP */ + uint8_t BootFileName[128]; /**< Legacy BOOTP protocol field, unused for DHCP */ + + uint32_t Cookie; /**< Magic BOOTP protocol cookie to indicate a valid packet */ + + uint8_t Options[]; /**< DHCP message options */ + } DHCP_Header_t; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint8_t DHCPCommon_SetOption(uint8_t* DHCPOptionList, + const uint8_t Option, + const uint8_t DataLen, + void* const OptionData); + bool DHCPCommon_GetOption(const uint8_t* DHCPOptionList, + const uint8_t Option, + void* const Destination); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPServerApp.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPServerApp.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fea54ddb0e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPServerApp.c @@ -0,0 +1,265 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * DHCP Server Application. When connected to the uIP stack, this will send IP configuration settings to a + * DHCP client on the network. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_DHCPSERVERAPP_C +#include "DHCPServerApp.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_DHCP_SERVER) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + +struct uip_conn* BroadcastConnection; + +uint8_t LeasedIPs[255 / 8]; + +/** Initialization function for the DHCP server. */ +void DHCPServerApp_Init(void) +{ + /* Listen on port 67 for DHCP server connections from hosts */ + uip_listen(HTONS(DHCP_SERVER_PORT)); + + /* Create a new UDP connection to the DHCP server port for the DHCP solicitation */ + struct uip_udp_conn* BroadcastConnection = uip_udp_new(&uip_broadcast_addr, HTONS(DHCP_CLIENT_PORT)); + + /* If the connection was successfully created, bind it to the local DHCP client port */ + if (BroadcastConnection != NULL) + uip_udp_bind(BroadcastConnection, HTONS(DHCP_SERVER_PORT)); + + /* Set all IP addresses as unleased */ + memset(LeasedIPs, 0x00, sizeof(LeasedIPs)); +} + +/** uIP stack application callback for the DHCP server. This function must be called each time the TCP/IP stack + * needs a UDP packet to be processed. + */ +void DHCPServerApp_Callback(void) +{ + DHCP_Header_t* const AppData = (DHCP_Header_t*)uip_appdata; + uint16_t AppDataSize = 0; + + /* Only process when new data arrives - don't retransmit lost packets */ + if (uip_newdata()) + { + /* Get the DHCP message type (if present), otherwise early-abort */ + uint8_t DHCPMessageType; + if (!(DHCPCommon_GetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_MSG_TYPE, &DHCPMessageType))) + return; + + uip_ipaddr_t Netmask, GatewayIPAddress, PreferredClientIP; + struct uip_eth_addr RemoteMACAddress; + uint32_t TransactionID; + + /* Get configured network mask, gateway IP and extract out DHCP transaction ID and remote IP */ + uip_getnetmask(&Netmask); + uip_getdraddr(&GatewayIPAddress); + memcpy(&RemoteMACAddress, &AppData->ClientHardwareAddress, sizeof(struct uip_eth_addr)); + TransactionID = AppData->TransactionID; + + /* Try to extract out the client's preferred IP address if it is indicated in the packet */ + if (!(DHCPCommon_GetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_REQ_IPADDR, &PreferredClientIP))) + memcpy(&PreferredClientIP, &uip_all_zeroes_addr, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); + + switch (DHCPMessageType) + { + case DHCP_DISCOVER: + /* If no preference was made or the preferred IP is already taken, find a new address */ + if (DHCPServerApp_CheckIfIPLeased(&PreferredClientIP)) + DHCPServerApp_GetUnleasedIP(&PreferredClientIP); + + /* Create a new DHCP OFFER packet with the offered IP address */ + AppDataSize += DHCPServerApp_FillDHCPHeader(AppData, DHCP_OFFER, &RemoteMACAddress, &PreferredClientIP, TransactionID); + + /* Add network mask and router information to the list of DHCP OFFER packet options */ + AppDataSize += DHCPCommon_SetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_SUBNET_MASK, + sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t), &Netmask); + AppDataSize += DHCPCommon_SetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_ROUTER, + sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t), &GatewayIPAddress); + + /* Send the DHCP OFFER packet */ + uip_poll_conn(BroadcastConnection); + memcpy(&uip_udp_conn->ripaddr, &uip_broadcast_addr, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); + uip_udp_send(AppDataSize); + + break; + case DHCP_REQUEST: + /* Check to see if the requested IP address has already been leased to a client */ + if (!(DHCPServerApp_CheckIfIPLeased(&PreferredClientIP))) + { + /* Create a new DHCP ACK packet to accept the IP address lease */ + AppDataSize += DHCPServerApp_FillDHCPHeader(AppData, DHCP_ACK, &RemoteMACAddress, &PreferredClientIP, TransactionID); + + /* Add network mask and router information to the list of DHCP ACK packet options */ + AppDataSize += DHCPCommon_SetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_SUBNET_MASK, + sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t), &Netmask); + AppDataSize += DHCPCommon_SetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_ROUTER, + sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t), &GatewayIPAddress); + + /* Mark the requested IP as leased to a client */ + DHCPServerApp_LeaseIP(&PreferredClientIP); + } + else + { + /* Create a new DHCP NAK packet to reject the requested allocation */ + AppDataSize += DHCPServerApp_FillDHCPHeader(AppData, DHCP_NAK, &RemoteMACAddress, &uip_all_zeroes_addr, TransactionID); + } + + /* Send the DHCP ACK or NAK packet */ + uip_poll_conn(BroadcastConnection); + memcpy(&uip_udp_conn->ripaddr, &uip_broadcast_addr, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); + uip_udp_send(AppDataSize); + + break; + case DHCP_RELEASE: + /* Mark the IP address as released in the allocation table */ + DHCPServerApp_UnleaseIP(&uip_udp_conn->ripaddr); + break; + } + } +} + +/** Fills the DHCP packet response with the appropriate BOOTP header for DHCP. This fills out all the required + * fields, leaving only the additional DHCP options to be added to the packet before it is sent to the DHCP client. + * + * \param[out] DHCPHeader Location in the packet buffer where the BOOTP header should be written to + * \param[in] DHCPMessageType DHCP Message type, such as DHCP_DISCOVER + * \param[in] ClientHardwareAddress Client MAC address the created transaction should be directed to + * \param[in] PreferredClientIP Preferred IP that should be given to the client if it is unallocated + * \param[in] TransactionID Transaction ID the created transaction should be associated with + * + * \return Size in bytes of the created DHCP packet + */ +static uint16_t DHCPServerApp_FillDHCPHeader(DHCP_Header_t* const DHCPHeader, + const uint8_t DHCPMessageType, + const struct uip_eth_addr* const ClientHardwareAddress, + const uip_ipaddr_t* const PreferredClientIP, + const uint32_t TransactionID) +{ + /* Erase existing packet data so that we start will all 0x00 DHCP header data */ + memset(DHCPHeader, 0, sizeof(DHCP_Header_t)); + + DHCPHeader->Operation = DHCPMessageType; + DHCPHeader->HardwareType = DHCP_HTYPE_ETHERNET; + DHCPHeader->HardwareAddressLength = sizeof(MACAddress); + DHCPHeader->Hops = 0; + DHCPHeader->TransactionID = TransactionID; + DHCPHeader->ElapsedSeconds = 0; + DHCPHeader->Flags = 0; + memcpy(&DHCPHeader->NextServerIP, &uip_hostaddr, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); + memcpy(&DHCPHeader->YourIP, PreferredClientIP, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); + memcpy(&DHCPHeader->ClientHardwareAddress, ClientHardwareAddress, sizeof(struct uip_eth_addr)); + DHCPHeader->Cookie = DHCP_MAGIC_COOKIE; + + /* Add a DHCP message type and terminator options to the start of the DHCP options field */ + DHCPHeader->Options[0] = DHCP_OPTION_MSG_TYPE; + DHCPHeader->Options[1] = 1; + DHCPHeader->Options[2] = DHCPMessageType; + DHCPHeader->Options[3] = DHCP_OPTION_END; + + /* Calculate the total number of bytes added to the outgoing packet */ + return (sizeof(DHCP_Header_t) + 4); +} + +/** Checks to see if the nominated IP address has already been allocated to a client. + * + * \param[in] IPAddress IP Address whose lease status should be checked + * + * \pre The IP address must be within the same /24 subnet as the virtual webserver. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the IP has already been leased to a client, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool DHCPServerApp_CheckIfIPLeased(const uip_ipaddr_t* const IPAddress) +{ + uint8_t Byte = (IPAddress->u8[3] / 8); + uint8_t Mask = (1 << (IPAddress->u8[3] % 8)); + + /* Make sure that the requested IP address isn't already leased to the virtual server or another client */ + if (IPAddress->u8[3] && !(IPAddress->u8[3] == uip_hostaddr.u8[3]) && !(LeasedIPs[Byte] & Mask)) + return false; + else + return true; +} + +/** Retrieves the next unleased IP in the IP address pool. + * + * \param[out] NewIPAddress Location where the generated IP Address should be stored + */ +static void DHCPServerApp_GetUnleasedIP(uip_ipaddr_t* const NewIPAddress) +{ + uip_ipaddr_copy(NewIPAddress, &uip_hostaddr); + + /** Look through the current subnet, skipping the broadcast and zero IP addresses */ + for (uint8_t IP = 1; IP < 254; IP++) + { + /* Update new IP address to lease with the current IP address to test */ + NewIPAddress->u8[3] = IP; + + /* If we've found an unleased IP, abort with the updated IP stored for the called */ + if (!(DHCPServerApp_CheckIfIPLeased(NewIPAddress))) + return; + } +} + +/** Marks the given IP Address as leased in the address pool, so that it will not be + * allocated to another client unless it is first released. + * + * \param[in] IPAddress IP Address to mark as leased + * + * \pre The IP address must be within the same /24 subnet as the virtual webserver. + */ +static void DHCPServerApp_LeaseIP(const uip_ipaddr_t* const IPAddress) +{ + uint8_t Byte = (IPAddress->u8[3] / 8); + uint8_t Mask = (1 << (IPAddress->u8[3] % 8)); + + /* Mark the IP address as leased in the allocation table */ + LeasedIPs[Byte] |= Mask; +} + +/** Marks the given IP Address as not leased in the address pool, so that it can be + * allocated to another client upon request. + * + * \param[in] IPAddress IP Address to mark as not leased + * + * \pre The IP address must be within the same /24 subnet as the virtual webserver. + */ +static void DHCPServerApp_UnleaseIP(const uip_ipaddr_t* const IPAddress) +{ + uint8_t Byte = (IPAddress->u8[3] / 8); + uint8_t Mask = (1 << (IPAddress->u8[3] % 8)); + + /* Mark the IP address as unleased in the allocation table */ + LeasedIPs[Byte] &= ~Mask; +} +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPServerApp.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPServerApp.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a9dae7bf3a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPServerApp.h @@ -0,0 +1,64 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for DHCPServerApp.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DHCPSERVER_APP_H_ +#define _DHCPSERVER_APP_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <uip.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + #include "../Webserver.h" + #include "DHCPCommon.h" + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void DHCPServerApp_Init(void); + void DHCPServerApp_Callback(void); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_DHCPSERVERAPP_C) + static uint16_t DHCPServerApp_FillDHCPHeader(DHCP_Header_t* const DHCPHeader, + const uint8_t DHCPMessageType, + const struct uip_eth_addr* const ClientHardwareAddress, + const uip_ipaddr_t* const PreferredClientIP, + const uint32_t TransactionID); + static bool DHCPServerApp_CheckIfIPLeased(const uip_ipaddr_t* const IPAddress); + static void DHCPServerApp_GetUnleasedIP(uip_ipaddr_t* const NewIPAddress); + static void DHCPServerApp_LeaseIP(const uip_ipaddr_t* const IPAddress); + static void DHCPServerApp_UnleaseIP(const uip_ipaddr_t* const IPAddress); + #endif +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DataflashManager.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DataflashManager.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b1111ce39b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DataflashManager.c @@ -0,0 +1,534 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Functions to manage the physical Dataflash media, including reading and writing of + * blocks of data. These functions are called by the SCSI layer when data must be stored + * or retrieved to/from the physical storage media. If a different media is used (such + * as a SD card or EEPROM), functions similar to these will need to be generated. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_DATAFLASHMANAGER_C +#include "DataflashManager.h" + +/** Writes blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) to the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), from + * the pre-selected data OUT endpoint. This routine reads in OS sized blocks from the endpoint and writes + * them to the Dataflash in Dataflash page sized blocks. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Mass Storage Class configuration and state + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the write sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to write + */ +void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + bool UsingSecondBuffer = false; + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, CurrDFPageByte); + + /* Wait until endpoint is ready before continuing */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Write an endpoint packet sized data block to the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if the endpoint is currently empty */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + /* Clear the current endpoint bank */ + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + /* Wait until the host has sent another packet */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + } + + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Once all the Dataflash ICs have had their first buffers filled, switch buffers to maintain throughput */ + if (Dataflash_GetSelectedChip() == DATAFLASH_CHIP_MASK(DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS)) + UsingSecondBuffer = !(UsingSecondBuffer); + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* If less than one Dataflash page remaining, copy over the existing page to preserve trailing data */ + if ((TotalBlocks * (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) < (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF2 : DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + } +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2WRITE : DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, 0); + } + + /* Write one 16-byte chunk of data to the Dataflash */ + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + + /* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ + if (MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset) + return; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0x00); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + + /* If the endpoint is empty, clear it ready for the next packet from the host */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Reads blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) from the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), into + * the pre-selected data IN endpoint. This routine reads in Dataflash page sized blocks from the Dataflash + * and writes them in OS sized blocks to the endpoint. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to a structure containing a Mass Storage Class configuration and state + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the read sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to read + */ +void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, CurrDFPageByte); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + + /* Wait until endpoint is ready before continuing */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Read an endpoint packet sized data block from the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if the endpoint is currently full */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + { + /* Clear the endpoint bank to send its contents to the host */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Wait until the endpoint is ready for more data */ + if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) + return; + } + + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + } + + /* Read one 16-byte chunk of data from the Dataflash */ + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + + /* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ + if (MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset) + return; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* If the endpoint is full, send its contents to the host */ + if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Writes blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) to the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), from + * the given RAM buffer. This routine reads in OS sized blocks from the buffer and writes them to the + * Dataflash in Dataflash page sized blocks. This can be linked to FAT libraries to write files to the + * Dataflash. + * + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the write sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to write + * \param[in] BufferPtr Pointer to the data source RAM buffer + */ +void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + const uint8_t* BufferPtr) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + bool UsingSecondBuffer = false; + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, CurrDFPageByte); + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Write an endpoint packet sized data block to the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Once all the Dataflash ICs have had their first buffers filled, switch buffers to maintain throughput */ + if (Dataflash_GetSelectedChip() == DATAFLASH_CHIP_MASK(DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS)) + UsingSecondBuffer = !(UsingSecondBuffer); + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + /* If less than one Dataflash page remaining, copy over the existing page to preserve trailing data */ + if ((TotalBlocks * (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) < (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF2 : DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + } +#endif + + /* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2WRITE : DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, 0); + } + + /* Write one 16-byte chunk of data to the Dataflash */ + for (uint8_t ByteNum = 0; ByteNum < 16; ByteNum++) + Dataflash_SendByte(*(BufferPtr++)); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0x00); + Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Reads blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) from the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), into + * the preallocated RAM buffer. This routine reads in Dataflash page sized blocks from the Dataflash + * and writes them in OS sized blocks to the given buffer. This can be linked to FAT libraries to read + * the files stored on the Dataflash. + * + * \param[in] BlockAddress Data block starting address for the read sequence + * \param[in] TotalBlocks Number of blocks of data to read + * \param[out] BufferPtr Pointer to the data destination RAM buffer + */ +void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) +{ + uint16_t CurrDFPage = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint16_t CurrDFPageByte = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); + uint8_t CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + + /* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, CurrDFPageByte); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + + while (TotalBlocks) + { + uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + + /* Read an endpoint packet sized data block from the Dataflash */ + while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ + if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) + { + /* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; + CurrDFPage++; + + /* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ + Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + + /* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); + Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + } + + /* Read one 16-byte chunk of data from the Dataflash */ + for (uint8_t ByteNum = 0; ByteNum < 16; ByteNum++) + *(BufferPtr++) = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + + /* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ + CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + + /* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ + BytesInBlockDiv16++; + } + + /* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ + TotalBlocks--; + } + + /* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Disables the Dataflash memory write protection bits on the board Dataflash ICs, if enabled. */ +void DataflashManager_ResetDataflashProtections(void) +{ + /* Select first Dataflash chip, send the read status register command */ + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + + /* Check if sector protection is enabled */ + if (Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_SECTORPROTECTION_ON) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + + /* Send the commands to disable sector protection */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[0]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[1]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[2]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[3]); + } + + /* Select second Dataflash chip (if present on selected board), send read status register command */ + #if (DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS == 2) + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP2); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + + /* Check if sector protection is enabled */ + if (Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_SECTORPROTECTION_ON) + { + Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + + /* Send the commands to disable sector protection */ + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[0]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[1]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[2]); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[3]); + } + #endif + + /* Deselect current Dataflash chip */ + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Performs a simple test on the attached Dataflash IC(s) to ensure that they are working. + * + * \return Boolean \c true if all media chips are working, \c false otherwise + */ +bool DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation(void) +{ + uint8_t ReturnByte; + + /* Test first Dataflash IC is present and responding to commands */ + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_READMANUFACTURERDEVICEINFO); + ReturnByte = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + /* If returned data is invalid, fail the command */ + if (ReturnByte != DF_MANUFACTURER_ATMEL) + return false; + + #if (DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS == 2) + /* Test second Dataflash IC is present and responding to commands */ + Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP2); + Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_READMANUFACTURERDEVICEINFO); + ReturnByte = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + + /* If returned data is invalid, fail the command */ + if (ReturnByte != DF_MANUFACTURER_ATMEL) + return false; + #endif + + return true; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DataflashManager.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DataflashManager.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..367fbac8c4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DataflashManager.h @@ -0,0 +1,87 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for DataflashManager.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DATAFLASH_MANAGER_H_ +#define _DATAFLASH_MANAGER_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + + #include "../Descriptors.h" + + #include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h> + + /* Preprocessor Checks: */ + #if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE % 16) + #error Dataflash page size must be a multiple of 16 bytes. + #endif + + /* Defines: */ + /** Total number of bytes of the storage medium, comprised of one or more Dataflash ICs. */ + #define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES ((uint32_t)DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) + + /** Block size of the device. This is kept at 512 to remain compatible with the OS despite the underlying + * storage media (Dataflash) using a different native block size. Do not change this value. + */ + #define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE 512 + + /** Total number of blocks of the virtual memory for reporting to the host as the device's total capacity. Do not + * change this value; change VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES instead to alter the media size. + */ + #define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCKS (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES / VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + + /** Indicates if the disk is write protected or not. */ + #define DISK_READ_ONLY false + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks); + void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks); + void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + const uint8_t* BufferPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, + uint16_t TotalBlocks, + uint8_t* BufferPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + void DataflashManager_ResetDataflashProtections(void); + bool DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/00readme.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/00readme.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..80d8843d13 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/00readme.txt @@ -0,0 +1,135 @@ +FatFs Module Source Files R0.09a (C)ChaN, 2012 + + +FILES + + ffconf.h Configuration file for FatFs module. + ff.h Common include file for FatFs and application module. + ff.c FatFs module. + diskio.h Common include file for FatFs and disk I/O module. + diskio.c An example of glue function to attach existing disk I/O module to FatFs. + integer.h Integer type definitions for FatFs. + option Optional external functions. + + Low level disk I/O module is not included in this archive because the FatFs + module is only a generic file system layer and not depend on any specific + storage device. You have to provide a low level disk I/O module that written + to control your storage device. + + + +AGREEMENTS + + FatFs module is an open source software to implement FAT file system to + small embedded systems. This is a free software and is opened for education, + research and commercial developments under license policy of following trems. + + Copyright (C) 2012, ChaN, all right reserved. + + * The FatFs module is a free software and there is NO WARRANTY. + * No restriction on use. You can use, modify and redistribute it for + personal, non-profit or commercial product UNDER YOUR RESPONSIBILITY. + * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice. + + + +REVISION HISTORY + + Feb 26, 2006 R0.00 Prototype + + Apr 29, 2006 R0.01 First release. + + Jun 01, 2006 R0.02 Added FAT12. + Removed unbuffered mode. + Fixed a problem on small (<32M) patition. + + Jun 10, 2006 R0.02a Added a configuration option _FS_MINIMUM. + + Sep 22, 2006 R0.03 Added f_rename. + Changed option _FS_MINIMUM to _FS_MINIMIZE. + + Dec 11, 2006 R0.03a Improved cluster scan algolithm to write files fast. + Fixed f_mkdir creates incorrect directory on FAT32. + + Feb 04, 2007 R0.04 Supported multiple drive system. (FatFs) + Changed some APIs for multiple drive system. + Added f_mkfs. (FatFs) + Added _USE_FAT32 option. (Tiny-FatFs) + + Apr 01, 2007 R0.04a Supported multiple partitions on a plysical drive. (FatFs) + Fixed an endian sensitive code in f_mkfs. (FatFs) + Added a capability of extending the file size to f_lseek. + Added minimization level 3. + Fixed a problem that can collapse a sector when recreate an + existing file in any sub-directory at non FAT32 cfg. (Tiny-FatFs) + + May 05, 2007 R0.04b Added _USE_NTFLAG option. + Added FSInfo support. + Fixed some problems corresponds to FAT32. (Tiny-FatFs) + Fixed DBCS name can result FR_INVALID_NAME. + Fixed short seek (0 < ofs <= csize) collapses the file object. + + Aug 25, 2007 R0.05 Changed arguments of f_read, f_write. + Changed arguments of f_mkfs. (FatFs) + Fixed f_mkfs on FAT32 creates incorrect FSInfo. (FatFs) + Fixed f_mkdir on FAT32 creates incorrect directory. (FatFs) + + Feb 03, 2008 R0.05a Added f_truncate(). + Added f_utime(). + Fixed off by one error at FAT sub-type determination. + Fixed btr in f_read() can be mistruncated. + Fixed cached sector is not flushed when create and close without write. + + Apr 01, 2008 R0.06 Added f_forward(). (Tiny-FatFs) + Added string functions: fputc(), fputs(), fprintf() and fgets(). + Improved performance of f_lseek() on move to the same or following cluster. + + Apr 01, 2009, R0.07 Merged Tiny-FatFs as a buffer configuration option. + Added long file name support. + Added multiple code page support. + Added re-entrancy for multitask operation. + Added auto cluster size selection to f_mkfs(). + Added rewind option to f_readdir(). + Changed result code of critical errors. + Renamed string functions to avoid name collision. + + Apr 14, 2009, R0.07a Separated out OS dependent code on reentrant cfg. + Added multiple sector size support. + + Jun 21, 2009, R0.07c Fixed f_unlink() may return FR_OK on error. + Fixed wrong cache control in f_lseek(). + Added relative path feature. + Added f_chdir(). + Added f_chdrive(). + Added proper case conversion for extended characters. + + Nov 03, 2009 R0.07e Separated out configuration options from ff.h to ffconf.h. + Added a configuration option, _LFN_UNICODE. + Fixed f_unlink() fails to remove a sub-dir on _FS_RPATH. + Fixed name matching error on the 13 char boundary. + Changed f_readdir() to return the SFN with always upper case on non-LFN cfg. + + May 15, 2010, R0.08 Added a memory configuration option. (_USE_LFN) + Added file lock feature. (_FS_SHARE) + Added fast seek feature. (_USE_FASTSEEK) + Changed some types on the API, XCHAR->TCHAR. + Changed fname member in the FILINFO structure on Unicode cfg. + String functions support UTF-8 encoding files on Unicode cfg. + + Aug 16,'10 R0.08a Added f_getcwd(). (_FS_RPATH = 2) + Added sector erase feature. (_USE_ERASE) + Moved file lock semaphore table from fs object to the bss. + Fixed a wrong directory entry is created on non-LFN cfg when the given name contains ';'. + Fixed f_mkfs() creates wrong FAT32 volume. + + Jan 15,'11 R0.08b Fast seek feature is also applied to f_read() and f_write(). + f_lseek() reports required table size on creating CLMP. + Extended format syntax of f_printf function. + Ignores duplicated directory separators in given path names. + + Sep 06,'11 R0.09 f_mkfs() supports multiple partition to finish the multiple partition feature. + Added f_fdisk(). (_MULTI_PARTITION = 2) + + Aug 27,'12 R0.09a Fixed assertion failure due to OS/2 EA on FAT12/16. + Changed API rejects null object pointer to avoid crash. + Changed option name _FS_SHARE to _FS_LOCK. diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/diskio.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/diskio.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b119b1a402 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/diskio.c @@ -0,0 +1,65 @@ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Low level disk I/O module skeleton for FatFs (C)ChaN, 2007 */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* This is a stub disk I/O module that acts as front end of the existing */ +/* disk I/O modules and attach it to FatFs module with common interface. */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#include "diskio.h" + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Initialize a Drive */ + +DSTATUS disk_initialize ( + BYTE drv /* Physical drive number (0..) */ +) +{ + return FR_OK; +} + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Return Disk Status */ + +DSTATUS disk_status ( + BYTE drv /* Physical drive number (0..) */ +) +{ + return FR_OK; +} + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Read Sector(s) */ + +DRESULT disk_read ( + BYTE drv, /* Physical drive number (0..) */ + BYTE *buff, /* Data buffer to store read data */ + DWORD sector, /* Sector address (LBA) */ + BYTE count /* Number of sectors to read (1..128) */ +) +{ + DataflashManager_ReadBlocks_RAM(sector, count, buff); + return RES_OK; +} + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Write Sector(s) */ + +#if _READONLY == 0 +DRESULT disk_write ( + BYTE drv, /* Physical drive number (0..) */ + const BYTE *buff, /* Data to be written */ + DWORD sector, /* Sector address (LBA) */ + BYTE count /* Number of sectors to write (1..128) */ +) +{ + DataflashManager_WriteBlocks_RAM(sector, count, buff); + return RES_OK; +} +#endif /* _READONLY */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/diskio.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/diskio.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..65e3048a0a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/diskio.h @@ -0,0 +1,52 @@ +/*----------------------------------------------------------------------- +/ Low level disk interface module include file +/-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#ifndef _DISKIO_DEFINED +#define _DISKIO_DEFINED + +#ifdef __cplusplus +extern "C" { +#endif + +#include "integer.h" +#include "ff.h" + +#include "../DataflashManager.h" + + +/* Status of Disk Functions */ +typedef BYTE DSTATUS; + +/* Results of Disk Functions */ +typedef enum { + RES_OK = 0, /* 0: Successful */ + RES_ERROR, /* 1: R/W Error */ + RES_WRPRT, /* 2: Write Protected */ + RES_NOTRDY, /* 3: Not Ready */ + RES_PARERR /* 4: Invalid Parameter */ +} DRESULT; + + +/*---------------------------------------*/ +/* Prototypes for disk control functions */ + +DSTATUS disk_initialize (BYTE); +DSTATUS disk_status (BYTE); +DRESULT disk_read (BYTE, BYTE*, DWORD, BYTE); +DRESULT disk_write (BYTE, const BYTE*, DWORD, BYTE); +DRESULT disk_ioctl (BYTE, BYTE, void*); + + +/* Disk Status Bits (DSTATUS) */ + +#define STA_NOINIT 0x01 /* Drive not initialized */ +#define STA_NODISK 0x02 /* No medium in the drive */ +#define STA_PROTECT 0x04 /* Write protected */ + + +#ifdef __cplusplus +} +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/ff.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/ff.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2f58adf837 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/ff.c @@ -0,0 +1,4139 @@ +/*----------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ FatFs - FAT file system module R0.09a (C)ChaN, 2012 +/-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ FatFs module is a generic FAT file system module for small embedded systems. +/ This is a free software that opened for education, research and commercial +/ developments under license policy of following terms. +/ +/ Copyright (C) 2012, ChaN, all right reserved. +/ +/ * The FatFs module is a free software and there is NO WARRANTY. +/ * No restriction on use. You can use, modify and redistribute it for +/ personal, non-profit or commercial products UNDER YOUR RESPONSIBILITY. +/ * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice. +/ +/-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ Feb 26,'06 R0.00 Prototype. +/ +/ Apr 29,'06 R0.01 First stable version. +/ +/ Jun 01,'06 R0.02 Added FAT12 support. +/ Removed unbuffered mode. +/ Fixed a problem on small (<32M) partition. +/ Jun 10,'06 R0.02a Added a configuration option (_FS_MINIMUM). +/ +/ Sep 22,'06 R0.03 Added f_rename(). +/ Changed option _FS_MINIMUM to _FS_MINIMIZE. +/ Dec 11,'06 R0.03a Improved cluster scan algorithm to write files fast. +/ Fixed f_mkdir() creates incorrect directory on FAT32. +/ +/ Feb 04,'07 R0.04 Supported multiple drive system. +/ Changed some interfaces for multiple drive system. +/ Changed f_mountdrv() to f_mount(). +/ Added f_mkfs(). +/ Apr 01,'07 R0.04a Supported multiple partitions on a physical drive. +/ Added a capability of extending file size to f_lseek(). +/ Added minimization level 3. +/ Fixed an endian sensitive code in f_mkfs(). +/ May 05,'07 R0.04b Added a configuration option _USE_NTFLAG. +/ Added FSInfo support. +/ Fixed DBCS name can result FR_INVALID_NAME. +/ Fixed short seek (<= csize) collapses the file object. +/ +/ Aug 25,'07 R0.05 Changed arguments of f_read(), f_write() and f_mkfs(). +/ Fixed f_mkfs() on FAT32 creates incorrect FSInfo. +/ Fixed f_mkdir() on FAT32 creates incorrect directory. +/ Feb 03,'08 R0.05a Added f_truncate() and f_utime(). +/ Fixed off by one error at FAT sub-type determination. +/ Fixed btr in f_read() can be mistruncated. +/ Fixed cached sector is not flushed when create and close without write. +/ +/ Apr 01,'08 R0.06 Added fputc(), fputs(), fprintf() and fgets(). +/ Improved performance of f_lseek() on moving to the same or following cluster. +/ +/ Apr 01,'09 R0.07 Merged Tiny-FatFs as a configuration option. (_FS_TINY) +/ Added long file name feature. +/ Added multiple code page feature. +/ Added re-entrancy for multitask operation. +/ Added auto cluster size selection to f_mkfs(). +/ Added rewind option to f_readdir(). +/ Changed result code of critical errors. +/ Renamed string functions to avoid name collision. +/ Apr 14,'09 R0.07a Separated out OS dependent code on reentrant cfg. +/ Added multiple sector size feature. +/ Jun 21,'09 R0.07c Fixed f_unlink() can return FR_OK on error. +/ Fixed wrong cache control in f_lseek(). +/ Added relative path feature. +/ Added f_chdir() and f_chdrive(). +/ Added proper case conversion to extended char. +/ Nov 03,'09 R0.07e Separated out configuration options from ff.h to ffconf.h. +/ Fixed f_unlink() fails to remove a sub-dir on _FS_RPATH. +/ Fixed name matching error on the 13 char boundary. +/ Added a configuration option, _LFN_UNICODE. +/ Changed f_readdir() to return the SFN with always upper case on non-LFN cfg. +/ +/ May 15,'10 R0.08 Added a memory configuration option. (_USE_LFN = 3) +/ Added file lock feature. (_FS_SHARE) +/ Added fast seek feature. (_USE_FASTSEEK) +/ Changed some types on the API, XCHAR->TCHAR. +/ Changed fname member in the FILINFO structure on Unicode cfg. +/ String functions support UTF-8 encoding files on Unicode cfg. +/ Aug 16,'10 R0.08a Added f_getcwd(). (_FS_RPATH = 2) +/ Added sector erase feature. (_USE_ERASE) +/ Moved file lock semaphore table from fs object to the bss. +/ Fixed a wrong directory entry is created on non-LFN cfg when the given name contains ';'. +/ Fixed f_mkfs() creates wrong FAT32 volume. +/ Jan 15,'11 R0.08b Fast seek feature is also applied to f_read() and f_write(). +/ f_lseek() reports required table size on creating CLMP. +/ Extended format syntax of f_printf function. +/ Ignores duplicated directory separators in given path name. +/ +/ Sep 06,'11 R0.09 f_mkfs() supports multiple partition to finish the multiple partition feature. +/ Added f_fdisk(). (_MULTI_PARTITION = 2) +/ Aug 27,'12 R0.09a Fixed assertion failure due to OS/2 EA on FAT12/16 volume. +/ Changed f_open() and f_opendir reject null object pointer to avoid crash. +/ Changed option name _FS_SHARE to _FS_LOCK. +/---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#include "ff.h" /* FatFs configurations and declarations */ +#include "diskio.h" /* Declarations of low level disk I/O functions */ + + +/*-------------------------------------------------------------------------- + + Module Private Definitions + +---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#if _FATFS != 4004 /* Revision ID */ +#error Wrong include file (ff.h). +#endif + + +/* Definitions on sector size */ +#if _MAX_SS != 512 && _MAX_SS != 1024 && _MAX_SS != 2048 && _MAX_SS != 4096 +#error Wrong sector size. +#endif +#if _MAX_SS != 512 +#define SS(fs) ((fs)->ssize) /* Variable sector size */ +#else +#define SS(fs) 512U /* Fixed sector size */ +#endif + + +/* Reentrancy related */ +#if _FS_REENTRANT +#if _USE_LFN == 1 +#error Static LFN work area must not be used in re-entrant configuration. +#endif +#define ENTER_FF(fs) { if (!lock_fs(fs)) return FR_TIMEOUT; } +#define LEAVE_FF(fs, res) { unlock_fs(fs, res); return res; } +#else +#define ENTER_FF(fs) +#define LEAVE_FF(fs, res) return res +#endif + +#define ABORT(fs, res) { fp->flag |= FA__ERROR; LEAVE_FF(fs, res); } + + +/* File access control feature */ +#if _FS_LOCK +#if _FS_READONLY +#error _FS_LOCK must be 0 on read-only cfg. +#endif +typedef struct { + FATFS *fs; /* File ID 1, volume (NULL:blank entry) */ + DWORD clu; /* File ID 2, directory */ + WORD idx; /* File ID 3, directory index */ + WORD ctr; /* File open counter, 0:none, 0x01..0xFF:read open count, 0x100:write mode */ +} FILESEM; +#endif + + + +/* DBCS code ranges and SBCS extend char conversion table */ + +#if _CODE_PAGE == 932 /* Japanese Shift-JIS */ +#define _DF1S 0x81 /* DBC 1st byte range 1 start */ +#define _DF1E 0x9F /* DBC 1st byte range 1 end */ +#define _DF2S 0xE0 /* DBC 1st byte range 2 start */ +#define _DF2E 0xFC /* DBC 1st byte range 2 end */ +#define _DS1S 0x40 /* DBC 2nd byte range 1 start */ +#define _DS1E 0x7E /* DBC 2nd byte range 1 end */ +#define _DS2S 0x80 /* DBC 2nd byte range 2 start */ +#define _DS2E 0xFC /* DBC 2nd byte range 2 end */ + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 936 /* Simplified Chinese GBK */ +#define _DF1S 0x81 +#define _DF1E 0xFE +#define _DS1S 0x40 +#define _DS1E 0x7E +#define _DS2S 0x80 +#define _DS2E 0xFE + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 949 /* Korean */ +#define _DF1S 0x81 +#define _DF1E 0xFE +#define _DS1S 0x41 +#define _DS1E 0x5A +#define _DS2S 0x61 +#define _DS2E 0x7A +#define _DS3S 0x81 +#define _DS3E 0xFE + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 950 /* Traditional Chinese Big5 */ +#define _DF1S 0x81 +#define _DF1E 0xFE +#define _DS1S 0x40 +#define _DS1E 0x7E +#define _DS2S 0xA1 +#define _DS2E 0xFE + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 437 /* U.S. (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x9A,0x90,0x41,0x8E,0x41,0x8F,0x80,0x45,0x45,0x45,0x49,0x49,0x49,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0x4F,0x99,0x4F,0x55,0x55,0x59,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0x41,0x49,0x4F,0x55,0xA5,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0x21,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE4,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE8,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 720 /* Arabic (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x45,0x41,0x84,0x41,0x86,0x43,0x45,0x45,0x45,0x49,0x49,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x49,0x49,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0xA1,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE4,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE8,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 737 /* Greek (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87, \ + 0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0xAA,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0x97,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xE4,0xED,0xEE,0xE7,0xE8,0xF1,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 775 /* Baltic (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x9A,0x91,0xA0,0x8E,0x95,0x8F,0x80,0xAD,0xED,0x8A,0x8A,0xA1,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0xE2,0x99,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x97,0x99,0x9A,0x9D,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0xA1,0xE0,0xA3,0xA3,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xBD,0xBE,0xC6,0xC7,0xA5,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE5,0xE5,0xE6,0xE3,0xE8,0xE8,0xEA,0xEA,0xEE,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 850 /* Multilingual Latin 1 (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x9A,0x90,0xB6,0x8E,0xB7,0x8F,0x80,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD8,0xD7,0xDE,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0xE2,0x99,0xE3,0xEA,0xEB,0x59,0x99,0x9A,0x9D,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xB5,0xD6,0xE0,0xE9,0xA5,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0x21,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC7,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE5,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE7,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xED,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 852 /* Latin 2 (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x9A,0x90,0xB6,0x8E,0xDE,0x8F,0x80,0x9D,0xD3,0x8A,0x8A,0xD7,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x91,0xE2,0x99,0x95,0x95,0x97,0x97,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9B,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xB5,0xD6,0xE0,0xE9,0xA4,0xA4,0xA6,0xA6,0xA8,0xA8,0xAA,0x8D,0xAC,0xB8,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBD,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC6,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD1,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD2,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xB7,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE3,0xD5,0xE6,0xE6,0xE8,0xE9,0xE8,0xEB,0xED,0xED,0xDD,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xEB,0xFC,0xFC,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 855 /* Cyrillic (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x81,0x81,0x83,0x83,0x85,0x85,0x87,0x87,0x89,0x89,0x8B,0x8B,0x8D,0x8D,0x8F,0x8F,0x91,0x91,0x93,0x93,0x95,0x95,0x97,0x97,0x99,0x99,0x9B,0x9B,0x9D,0x9D,0x9F,0x9F, \ + 0xA1,0xA1,0xA3,0xA3,0xA5,0xA5,0xA7,0xA7,0xA9,0xA9,0xAB,0xAB,0xAD,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB6,0xB6,0xB8,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBE,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC7,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD1,0xD1,0xD3,0xD3,0xD5,0xD5,0xD7,0xD7,0xDD,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xE0,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE2,0xE2,0xE4,0xE4,0xE6,0xE6,0xE8,0xE8,0xEA,0xEA,0xEC,0xEC,0xEE,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF2,0xF2,0xF4,0xF4,0xF6,0xF6,0xF8,0xF8,0xFA,0xFA,0xFC,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 857 /* Turkish (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x9A,0x90,0xB6,0x8E,0xB7,0x8F,0x80,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD8,0xD7,0x98,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0xE2,0x99,0xE3,0xEA,0xEB,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9D,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9E, \ + 0xB5,0xD6,0xE0,0xE9,0xA5,0xA5,0xA6,0xA6,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0x21,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC7,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE5,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE8,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xDE,0x59,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 858 /* Multilingual Latin 1 + Euro (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x9A,0x90,0xB6,0x8E,0xB7,0x8F,0x80,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD8,0xD7,0xDE,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0xE2,0x99,0xE3,0xEA,0xEB,0x59,0x99,0x9A,0x9D,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xB5,0xD6,0xE0,0xE9,0xA5,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0x21,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC7,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD1,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE5,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE7,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xED,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 862 /* Hebrew (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0x41,0x49,0x4F,0x55,0xA5,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0x21,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE4,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE8,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 866 /* Russian (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x9d,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F,0xF0,0xF0,0xF2,0xF2,0xF4,0xF4,0xF6,0xF6,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 874 /* Thai (OEM, Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0xA1,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE4,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE8,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1250 /* Central Europe (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x8A,0x9B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F, \ + 0xA0,0xA1,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xA3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xA5,0xAA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBC,0xAF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xF7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1251 /* Cyrillic (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x82,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x80,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x8A,0x9B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F, \ + 0xA0,0xA2,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB2,0xA5,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xA8,0xB9,0xAA,0xBB,0xA3,0xBD,0xBD,0xAF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1252 /* Latin 1 (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0xAd,0x9B,0x8C,0x9D,0xAE,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0x21,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xF7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0x9F} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1253 /* Greek (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0xA1,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xA2,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA, \ + 0xE0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xF2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xFB,0xBC,0xFD,0xBF,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1254 /* Turkish (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x8A,0x9B,0x8C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0x21,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xF7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0x9F} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1255 /* Hebrew (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0x21,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE4,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE8,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1256 /* Arabic (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x8C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0xA1,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0x41,0xE1,0x41,0xE3,0xE4,0xE5,0xE6,0x43,0x45,0x45,0x45,0x45,0xEC,0xED,0x49,0x49,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0x4F,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0x55,0xFA,0x55,0x55,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1257 /* Baltic (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0xA1,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xA8,0xB9,0xAA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xAF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xF7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1258 /* Vietnam (OEM, Windows) */ +#define _DF1S 0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0xAC,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ + 0xA0,0x21,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ + 0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xEC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xF2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xF7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xFE,0x9F} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1 /* ASCII (for only non-LFN cfg) */ +#if _USE_LFN +#error Cannot use LFN feature without valid code page. +#endif +#define _DF1S 0 + +#else +#error Unknown code page + +#endif + + +/* Character code support macros */ +#define IsUpper(c) (((c)>='A')&&((c)<='Z')) +#define IsLower(c) (((c)>='a')&&((c)<='z')) +#define IsDigit(c) (((c)>='0')&&((c)<='9')) + +#if _DF1S /* Code page is DBCS */ + +#ifdef _DF2S /* Two 1st byte areas */ +#define IsDBCS1(c) (((BYTE)(c) >= _DF1S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DF1E) || ((BYTE)(c) >= _DF2S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DF2E)) +#else /* One 1st byte area */ +#define IsDBCS1(c) ((BYTE)(c) >= _DF1S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DF1E) +#endif + +#ifdef _DS3S /* Three 2nd byte areas */ +#define IsDBCS2(c) (((BYTE)(c) >= _DS1S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DS1E) || ((BYTE)(c) >= _DS2S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DS2E) || ((BYTE)(c) >= _DS3S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DS3E)) +#else /* Two 2nd byte areas */ +#define IsDBCS2(c) (((BYTE)(c) >= _DS1S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DS1E) || ((BYTE)(c) >= _DS2S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DS2E)) +#endif + +#else /* Code page is SBCS */ + +#define IsDBCS1(c) 0 +#define IsDBCS2(c) 0 + +#endif /* _DF1S */ + + +/* Name status flags */ +#define NS 11 /* Index of name status byte in fn[] */ +#define NS_LOSS 0x01 /* Out of 8.3 format */ +#define NS_LFN 0x02 /* Force to create LFN entry */ +#define NS_LAST 0x04 /* Last segment */ +#define NS_BODY 0x08 /* Lower case flag (body) */ +#define NS_EXT 0x10 /* Lower case flag (ext) */ +#define NS_DOT 0x20 /* Dot entry */ + + +/* FAT sub-type boundaries */ +/* Note that the FAT spec by Microsoft says 4085 but Windows works with 4087! */ +#define MIN_FAT16 4086 /* Minimum number of clusters for FAT16 */ +#define MIN_FAT32 65526 /* Minimum number of clusters for FAT32 */ + + +/* FatFs refers the members in the FAT structures as byte array instead of +/ structure member because the structure is not binary compatible between +/ different platforms */ + +#define BS_jmpBoot 0 /* Jump instruction (3) */ +#define BS_OEMName 3 /* OEM name (8) */ +#define BPB_BytsPerSec 11 /* Sector size [byte] (2) */ +#define BPB_SecPerClus 13 /* Cluster size [sector] (1) */ +#define BPB_RsvdSecCnt 14 /* Size of reserved area [sector] (2) */ +#define BPB_NumFATs 16 /* Number of FAT copies (1) */ +#define BPB_RootEntCnt 17 /* Number of root dir entries for FAT12/16 (2) */ +#define BPB_TotSec16 19 /* Volume size [sector] (2) */ +#define BPB_Media 21 /* Media descriptor (1) */ +#define BPB_FATSz16 22 /* FAT size [sector] (2) */ +#define BPB_SecPerTrk 24 /* Track size [sector] (2) */ +#define BPB_NumHeads 26 /* Number of heads (2) */ +#define BPB_HiddSec 28 /* Number of special hidden sectors (4) */ +#define BPB_TotSec32 32 /* Volume size [sector] (4) */ +#define BS_DrvNum 36 /* Physical drive number (2) */ +#define BS_BootSig 38 /* Extended boot signature (1) */ +#define BS_VolID 39 /* Volume serial number (4) */ +#define BS_VolLab 43 /* Volume label (8) */ +#define BS_FilSysType 54 /* File system type (1) */ +#define BPB_FATSz32 36 /* FAT size [sector] (4) */ +#define BPB_ExtFlags 40 /* Extended flags (2) */ +#define BPB_FSVer 42 /* File system version (2) */ +#define BPB_RootClus 44 /* Root dir first cluster (4) */ +#define BPB_FSInfo 48 /* Offset of FSInfo sector (2) */ +#define BPB_BkBootSec 50 /* Offset of backup boot sector (2) */ +#define BS_DrvNum32 64 /* Physical drive number (2) */ +#define BS_BootSig32 66 /* Extended boot signature (1) */ +#define BS_VolID32 67 /* Volume serial number (4) */ +#define BS_VolLab32 71 /* Volume label (8) */ +#define BS_FilSysType32 82 /* File system type (1) */ +#define FSI_LeadSig 0 /* FSI: Leading signature (4) */ +#define FSI_StrucSig 484 /* FSI: Structure signature (4) */ +#define FSI_Free_Count 488 /* FSI: Number of free clusters (4) */ +#define FSI_Nxt_Free 492 /* FSI: Last allocated cluster (4) */ +#define MBR_Table 446 /* MBR: Partition table offset (2) */ +#define SZ_PTE 16 /* MBR: Size of a partition table entry */ +#define BS_55AA 510 /* Boot sector signature (2) */ + +#define DIR_Name 0 /* Short file name (11) */ +#define DIR_Attr 11 /* Attribute (1) */ +#define DIR_NTres 12 /* NT flag (1) */ +#define DIR_CrtTimeTenth 13 /* Created time sub-second (1) */ +#define DIR_CrtTime 14 /* Created time (2) */ +#define DIR_CrtDate 16 /* Created date (2) */ +#define DIR_LstAccDate 18 /* Last accessed date (2) */ +#define DIR_FstClusHI 20 /* Higher 16-bit of first cluster (2) */ +#define DIR_WrtTime 22 /* Modified time (2) */ +#define DIR_WrtDate 24 /* Modified date (2) */ +#define DIR_FstClusLO 26 /* Lower 16-bit of first cluster (2) */ +#define DIR_FileSize 28 /* File size (4) */ +#define LDIR_Ord 0 /* LFN entry order and LLE flag (1) */ +#define LDIR_Attr 11 /* LFN attribute (1) */ +#define LDIR_Type 12 /* LFN type (1) */ +#define LDIR_Chksum 13 /* Sum of corresponding SFN entry */ +#define LDIR_FstClusLO 26 /* Filled by zero (0) */ +#define SZ_DIR 32 /* Size of a directory entry */ +#define LLE 0x40 /* Last long entry flag in LDIR_Ord */ +#define DDE 0xE5 /* Deleted directory entry mark in DIR_Name[0] */ +#define NDDE 0x05 /* Replacement of the character collides with DDE */ + + +/*------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Module private work area */ +/*------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Note that uninitialized variables with static duration are +/ zeroed/nulled at start-up. If not, the compiler or start-up +/ routine is out of ANSI-C standard. +*/ + +#if _VOLUMES +static +FATFS *FatFs[_VOLUMES]; /* Pointer to the file system objects (logical drives) */ +#else +#error Number of volumes must not be 0. +#endif + +static +WORD Fsid; /* File system mount ID */ + +#if _FS_RPATH +static +BYTE CurrVol; /* Current drive */ +#endif + +#if _FS_LOCK +static +FILESEM Files[_FS_LOCK]; /* File lock semaphores */ +#endif + +#if _USE_LFN == 0 /* No LFN feature */ +#define DEF_NAMEBUF BYTE sfn[12] +#define INIT_BUF(dobj) (dobj).fn = sfn +#define FREE_BUF() + +#elif _USE_LFN == 1 /* LFN feature with static working buffer */ +static WCHAR LfnBuf[_MAX_LFN+1]; +#define DEF_NAMEBUF BYTE sfn[12] +#define INIT_BUF(dobj) { (dobj).fn = sfn; (dobj).lfn = LfnBuf; } +#define FREE_BUF() + +#elif _USE_LFN == 2 /* LFN feature with dynamic working buffer on the stack */ +#define DEF_NAMEBUF BYTE sfn[12]; WCHAR lbuf[_MAX_LFN+1] +#define INIT_BUF(dobj) { (dobj).fn = sfn; (dobj).lfn = lbuf; } +#define FREE_BUF() + +#elif _USE_LFN == 3 /* LFN feature with dynamic working buffer on the heap */ +#define DEF_NAMEBUF BYTE sfn[12]; WCHAR *lfn +#define INIT_BUF(dobj) { lfn = ff_memalloc((_MAX_LFN + 1) * 2); \ + if (!lfn) LEAVE_FF((dobj).fs, FR_NOT_ENOUGH_CORE); \ + (dobj).lfn = lfn; (dobj).fn = sfn; } +#define FREE_BUF() ff_memfree(lfn) + +#else +#error Wrong LFN configuration. +#endif + + + + +/*-------------------------------------------------------------------------- + + Module Private Functions + +---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* String functions */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +/* Copy memory to memory */ +static +void mem_cpy (void* dst, const void* src, UINT cnt) { + BYTE *d = (BYTE*)dst; + const BYTE *s = (const BYTE*)src; + +#if _WORD_ACCESS == 1 + while (cnt >= sizeof (int)) { + *(int*)d = *(int*)s; + d += sizeof (int); s += sizeof (int); + cnt -= sizeof (int); + } +#endif + while (cnt--) + *d++ = *s++; +} + +/* Fill memory */ +static +void mem_set (void* dst, int val, UINT cnt) { + BYTE *d = (BYTE*)dst; + + while (cnt--) + *d++ = (BYTE)val; +} + +/* Compare memory to memory */ +static +int mem_cmp (const void* dst, const void* src, UINT cnt) { + const BYTE *d = (const BYTE *)dst, *s = (const BYTE *)src; + int r = 0; + + while (cnt-- && (r = *d++ - *s++) == 0) ; + return r; +} + +/* Check if chr is contained in the string */ +static +int chk_chr (const char* str, int chr) { + while (*str && *str != chr) str++; + return *str; +} + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Request/Release grant to access the volume */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _FS_REENTRANT + +static +int lock_fs ( + FATFS *fs /* File system object */ +) +{ + return ff_req_grant(fs->sobj); +} + + +static +void unlock_fs ( + FATFS *fs, /* File system object */ + FRESULT res /* Result code to be returned */ +) +{ + if (fs && + res != FR_NOT_ENABLED && + res != FR_INVALID_DRIVE && + res != FR_INVALID_OBJECT && + res != FR_TIMEOUT) { + ff_rel_grant(fs->sobj); + } +} +#endif + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* File lock control functions */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _FS_LOCK + +static +FRESULT chk_lock ( /* Check if the file can be accessed */ + DIR* dj, /* Directory object pointing the file to be checked */ + int acc /* Desired access (0:Read, 1:Write, 2:Delete/Rename) */ +) +{ + UINT i, be; + + /* Search file semaphore table */ + for (i = be = 0; i < _FS_LOCK; i++) { + if (Files[i].fs) { /* Existing entry */ + if (Files[i].fs == dj->fs && /* Check if the file matched with an open file */ + Files[i].clu == dj->sclust && + Files[i].idx == dj->index) break; + } else { /* Blank entry */ + be++; + } + } + if (i == _FS_LOCK) /* The file is not opened */ + return (be || acc == 2) ? FR_OK : FR_TOO_MANY_OPEN_FILES; /* Is there a blank entry for new file? */ + + /* The file has been opened. Reject any open against writing file and all write mode open */ + return (acc || Files[i].ctr == 0x100) ? FR_LOCKED : FR_OK; +} + + +static +int enq_lock (void) /* Check if an entry is available for a new file */ +{ + UINT i; + + for (i = 0; i < _FS_LOCK && Files[i].fs; i++) ; + return (i == _FS_LOCK) ? 0 : 1; +} + + +static +UINT inc_lock ( /* Increment file open counter and returns its index (0:int error) */ + DIR* dj, /* Directory object pointing the file to register or increment */ + int acc /* Desired access mode (0:Read, !0:Write) */ +) +{ + UINT i; + + + for (i = 0; i < _FS_LOCK; i++) { /* Find the file */ + if (Files[i].fs == dj->fs && + Files[i].clu == dj->sclust && + Files[i].idx == dj->index) break; + } + + if (i == _FS_LOCK) { /* Not opened. Register it as new. */ + for (i = 0; i < _FS_LOCK && Files[i].fs; i++) ; + if (i == _FS_LOCK) return 0; /* No space to register (int err) */ + Files[i].fs = dj->fs; + Files[i].clu = dj->sclust; + Files[i].idx = dj->index; + Files[i].ctr = 0; + } + + if (acc && Files[i].ctr) return 0; /* Access violation (int err) */ + + Files[i].ctr = acc ? 0x100 : Files[i].ctr + 1; /* Set semaphore value */ + + return i + 1; +} + + +static +FRESULT dec_lock ( /* Decrement file open counter */ + UINT i /* Semaphore index */ +) +{ + WORD n; + FRESULT res; + + + if (--i < _FS_LOCK) { + n = Files[i].ctr; + if (n == 0x100) n = 0; + if (n) n--; + Files[i].ctr = n; + if (!n) Files[i].fs = 0; + res = FR_OK; + } else { + res = FR_INT_ERR; + } + return res; +} + + +static +void clear_lock ( /* Clear lock entries of the volume */ + FATFS *fs +) +{ + UINT i; + + for (i = 0; i < _FS_LOCK; i++) { + if (Files[i].fs == fs) Files[i].fs = 0; + } +} +#endif + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Change window offset */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT move_window ( + FATFS *fs, /* File system object */ + DWORD sector /* Sector number to make appearance in the fs->win[] */ +) /* Move to zero only writes back dirty window */ +{ + DWORD wsect; + + + wsect = fs->winsect; + if (wsect != sector) { /* Changed current window */ +#if !_FS_READONLY + if (fs->wflag) { /* Write back dirty window if needed */ + if (disk_write(fs->drv, fs->win, wsect, 1) != RES_OK) + return FR_DISK_ERR; + fs->wflag = 0; + if (wsect < (fs->fatbase + fs->fsize)) { /* In FAT area */ + BYTE nf; + for (nf = fs->n_fats; nf > 1; nf--) { /* Reflect the change to all FAT copies */ + wsect += fs->fsize; + disk_write(fs->drv, fs->win, wsect, 1); + } + } + } +#endif + if (sector) { + if (disk_read(fs->drv, fs->win, sector, 1) != RES_OK) + return FR_DISK_ERR; + fs->winsect = sector; + } + } + + return FR_OK; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Clean-up cached data */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if !_FS_READONLY +static +FRESULT sync ( /* FR_OK: successful, FR_DISK_ERR: failed */ + FATFS *fs /* File system object */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + + + res = move_window(fs, 0); + if (res == FR_OK) { + /* Update FSInfo sector if needed */ + if (fs->fs_type == FS_FAT32 && fs->fsi_flag) { + fs->winsect = 0; + /* Create FSInfo structure */ + mem_set(fs->win, 0, 512); + ST_WORD(fs->win+BS_55AA, 0xAA55); + ST_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_LeadSig, 0x41615252); + ST_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_StrucSig, 0x61417272); + ST_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_Free_Count, fs->free_clust); + ST_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_Nxt_Free, fs->last_clust); + /* Write it into the FSInfo sector */ + disk_write(fs->drv, fs->win, fs->fsi_sector, 1); + fs->fsi_flag = 0; + } + /* Make sure that no pending write process in the physical drive */ + if (disk_ioctl(fs->drv, CTRL_SYNC, 0) != RES_OK) + res = FR_DISK_ERR; + } + + return res; +} +#endif + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Get sector# from cluster# */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + + +DWORD clust2sect ( /* !=0: Sector number, 0: Failed - invalid cluster# */ + FATFS *fs, /* File system object */ + DWORD clst /* Cluster# to be converted */ +) +{ + clst -= 2; + if (clst >= (fs->n_fatent - 2)) return 0; /* Invalid cluster# */ + return clst * fs->csize + fs->database; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* FAT access - Read value of a FAT entry */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + + +DWORD get_fat ( /* 0xFFFFFFFF:Disk error, 1:Internal error, Else:Cluster status */ + FATFS *fs, /* File system object */ + DWORD clst /* Cluster# to get the link information */ +) +{ + UINT wc, bc; + BYTE *p; + + + if (clst < 2 || clst >= fs->n_fatent) /* Check range */ + return 1; + + switch (fs->fs_type) { + case FS_FAT12 : + bc = (UINT)clst; bc += bc / 2; + if (move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (bc / SS(fs)))) break; + wc = fs->win[bc % SS(fs)]; bc++; + if (move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (bc / SS(fs)))) break; + wc |= fs->win[bc % SS(fs)] << 8; + return (clst & 1) ? (wc >> 4) : (wc & 0xFFF); + + case FS_FAT16 : + if (move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (clst / (SS(fs) / 2)))) break; + p = &fs->win[clst * 2 % SS(fs)]; + return LD_WORD(p); + + case FS_FAT32 : + if (move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (clst / (SS(fs) / 4)))) break; + p = &fs->win[clst * 4 % SS(fs)]; + return LD_DWORD(p) & 0x0FFFFFFF; + } + + return 0xFFFFFFFF; /* An error occurred at the disk I/O layer */ +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* FAT access - Change value of a FAT entry */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if !_FS_READONLY + +FRESULT put_fat ( + FATFS *fs, /* File system object */ + DWORD clst, /* Cluster# to be changed in range of 2 to fs->n_fatent - 1 */ + DWORD val /* New value to mark the cluster */ +) +{ + UINT bc; + BYTE *p; + FRESULT res; + + + if (clst < 2 || clst >= fs->n_fatent) { /* Check range */ + res = FR_INT_ERR; + + } else { + switch (fs->fs_type) { + case FS_FAT12 : + bc = (UINT)clst; bc += bc / 2; + res = move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (bc / SS(fs))); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + p = &fs->win[bc % SS(fs)]; + *p = (clst & 1) ? ((*p & 0x0F) | ((BYTE)val << 4)) : (BYTE)val; + bc++; + fs->wflag = 1; + res = move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (bc / SS(fs))); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + p = &fs->win[bc % SS(fs)]; + *p = (clst & 1) ? (BYTE)(val >> 4) : ((*p & 0xF0) | ((BYTE)(val >> 8) & 0x0F)); + break; + + case FS_FAT16 : + res = move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (clst / (SS(fs) / 2))); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + p = &fs->win[clst * 2 % SS(fs)]; + ST_WORD(p, (WORD)val); + break; + + case FS_FAT32 : + res = move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (clst / (SS(fs) / 4))); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + p = &fs->win[clst * 4 % SS(fs)]; + val |= LD_DWORD(p) & 0xF0000000; + ST_DWORD(p, val); + break; + + default : + res = FR_INT_ERR; + } + fs->wflag = 1; + } + + return res; +} +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* FAT handling - Remove a cluster chain */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if !_FS_READONLY +static +FRESULT remove_chain ( + FATFS *fs, /* File system object */ + DWORD clst /* Cluster# to remove a chain from */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DWORD nxt; +#if _USE_ERASE + DWORD scl = clst, ecl = clst, rt[2]; +#endif + + if (clst < 2 || clst >= fs->n_fatent) { /* Check range */ + res = FR_INT_ERR; + + } else { + res = FR_OK; + while (clst < fs->n_fatent) { /* Not a last link? */ + nxt = get_fat(fs, clst); /* Get cluster status */ + if (nxt == 0) break; /* Empty cluster? */ + if (nxt == 1) { res = FR_INT_ERR; break; } /* Internal error? */ + if (nxt == 0xFFFFFFFF) { res = FR_DISK_ERR; break; } /* Disk error? */ + res = put_fat(fs, clst, 0); /* Mark the cluster "empty" */ + if (res != FR_OK) break; + if (fs->free_clust != 0xFFFFFFFF) { /* Update FSInfo */ + fs->free_clust++; + fs->fsi_flag = 1; + } +#if _USE_ERASE + if (ecl + 1 == nxt) { /* Is next cluster contiguous? */ + ecl = nxt; + } else { /* End of contiguous clusters */ + rt[0] = clust2sect(fs, scl); /* Start sector */ + rt[1] = clust2sect(fs, ecl) + fs->csize - 1; /* End sector */ + disk_ioctl(fs->drv, CTRL_ERASE_SECTOR, rt); /* Erase the block */ + scl = ecl = nxt; + } +#endif + clst = nxt; /* Next cluster */ + } + } + + return res; +} +#endif + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* FAT handling - Stretch or Create a cluster chain */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if !_FS_READONLY +static +DWORD create_chain ( /* 0:No free cluster, 1:Internal error, 0xFFFFFFFF:Disk error, >=2:New cluster# */ + FATFS *fs, /* File system object */ + DWORD clst /* Cluster# to stretch. 0 means create a new chain. */ +) +{ + DWORD cs, ncl, scl; + FRESULT res; + + + if (clst == 0) { /* Create a new chain */ + scl = fs->last_clust; /* Get suggested start point */ + if (!scl || scl >= fs->n_fatent) scl = 1; + } + else { /* Stretch the current chain */ + cs = get_fat(fs, clst); /* Check the cluster status */ + if (cs < 2) return 1; /* It is an invalid cluster */ + if (cs < fs->n_fatent) return cs; /* It is already followed by next cluster */ + scl = clst; + } + + ncl = scl; /* Start cluster */ + for (;;) { + ncl++; /* Next cluster */ + if (ncl >= fs->n_fatent) { /* Wrap around */ + ncl = 2; + if (ncl > scl) return 0; /* No free cluster */ + } + cs = get_fat(fs, ncl); /* Get the cluster status */ + if (cs == 0) break; /* Found a free cluster */ + if (cs == 0xFFFFFFFF || cs == 1)/* An error occurred */ + return cs; + if (ncl == scl) return 0; /* No free cluster */ + } + + res = put_fat(fs, ncl, 0x0FFFFFFF); /* Mark the new cluster "last link" */ + if (res == FR_OK && clst != 0) { + res = put_fat(fs, clst, ncl); /* Link it to the previous one if needed */ + } + if (res == FR_OK) { + fs->last_clust = ncl; /* Update FSINFO */ + if (fs->free_clust != 0xFFFFFFFF) { + fs->free_clust--; + fs->fsi_flag = 1; + } + } else { + ncl = (res == FR_DISK_ERR) ? 0xFFFFFFFF : 1; + } + + return ncl; /* Return new cluster number or error code */ +} +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* FAT handling - Convert offset into cluster with link map table */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#if _USE_FASTSEEK +static +DWORD clmt_clust ( /* <2:Error, >=2:Cluster number */ + FIL* fp, /* Pointer to the file object */ + DWORD ofs /* File offset to be converted to cluster# */ +) +{ + DWORD cl, ncl, *tbl; + + + tbl = fp->cltbl + 1; /* Top of CLMT */ + cl = ofs / SS(fp->fs) / fp->fs->csize; /* Cluster order from top of the file */ + for (;;) { + ncl = *tbl++; /* Number of cluters in the fragment */ + if (!ncl) return 0; /* End of table? (error) */ + if (cl < ncl) break; /* In this fragment? */ + cl -= ncl; tbl++; /* Next fragment */ + } + return cl + *tbl; /* Return the cluster number */ +} +#endif /* _USE_FASTSEEK */ + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Directory handling - Set directory index */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT dir_sdi ( + DIR *dj, /* Pointer to directory object */ + WORD idx /* Index of directory table */ +) +{ + DWORD clst; + WORD ic; + + + dj->index = idx; + clst = dj->sclust; + if (clst == 1 || clst >= dj->fs->n_fatent) /* Check start cluster range */ + return FR_INT_ERR; + if (!clst && dj->fs->fs_type == FS_FAT32) /* Replace cluster# 0 with root cluster# if in FAT32 */ + clst = dj->fs->dirbase; + + if (clst == 0) { /* Static table (root-dir in FAT12/16) */ + dj->clust = clst; + if (idx >= dj->fs->n_rootdir) /* Index is out of range */ + return FR_INT_ERR; + dj->sect = dj->fs->dirbase + idx / (SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR); /* Sector# */ + } + else { /* Dynamic table (sub-dirs or root-dir in FAT32) */ + ic = SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR * dj->fs->csize; /* Entries per cluster */ + while (idx >= ic) { /* Follow cluster chain */ + clst = get_fat(dj->fs, clst); /* Get next cluster */ + if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) return FR_DISK_ERR; /* Disk error */ + if (clst < 2 || clst >= dj->fs->n_fatent) /* Reached to end of table or int error */ + return FR_INT_ERR; + idx -= ic; + } + dj->clust = clst; + dj->sect = clust2sect(dj->fs, clst) + idx / (SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR); /* Sector# */ + } + + dj->dir = dj->fs->win + (idx % (SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR)) * SZ_DIR; /* Ptr to the entry in the sector */ + + return FR_OK; /* Seek succeeded */ +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Directory handling - Move directory table index next */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT dir_next ( /* FR_OK:Succeeded, FR_NO_FILE:End of table, FR_DENIED:EOT and could not stretch */ + DIR *dj, /* Pointer to directory object */ + int stretch /* 0: Do not stretch table, 1: Stretch table if needed */ +) +{ + DWORD clst; + WORD i; + + + stretch = stretch; /* To suppress warning on read-only cfg. */ + i = dj->index + 1; + if (!i || !dj->sect) /* Report EOT when index has reached 65535 */ + return FR_NO_FILE; + + if (!(i % (SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR))) { /* Sector changed? */ + dj->sect++; /* Next sector */ + + if (dj->clust == 0) { /* Static table */ + if (i >= dj->fs->n_rootdir) /* Report EOT when end of table */ + return FR_NO_FILE; + } + else { /* Dynamic table */ + if (((i / (SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR)) & (dj->fs->csize - 1)) == 0) { /* Cluster changed? */ + clst = get_fat(dj->fs, dj->clust); /* Get next cluster */ + if (clst <= 1) return FR_INT_ERR; + if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) return FR_DISK_ERR; + if (clst >= dj->fs->n_fatent) { /* When it reached end of dynamic table */ +#if !_FS_READONLY + BYTE c; + if (!stretch) return FR_NO_FILE; /* When do not stretch, report EOT */ + clst = create_chain(dj->fs, dj->clust); /* Stretch cluster chain */ + if (clst == 0) return FR_DENIED; /* No free cluster */ + if (clst == 1) return FR_INT_ERR; + if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) return FR_DISK_ERR; + /* Clean-up stretched table */ + if (move_window(dj->fs, 0)) return FR_DISK_ERR; /* Flush active window */ + mem_set(dj->fs->win, 0, SS(dj->fs)); /* Clear window buffer */ + dj->fs->winsect = clust2sect(dj->fs, clst); /* Cluster start sector */ + for (c = 0; c < dj->fs->csize; c++) { /* Fill the new cluster with 0 */ + dj->fs->wflag = 1; + if (move_window(dj->fs, 0)) return FR_DISK_ERR; + dj->fs->winsect++; + } + dj->fs->winsect -= c; /* Rewind window address */ +#else + return FR_NO_FILE; /* Report EOT */ +#endif + } + dj->clust = clst; /* Initialize data for new cluster */ + dj->sect = clust2sect(dj->fs, clst); + } + } + } + + dj->index = i; + dj->dir = dj->fs->win + (i % (SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR)) * SZ_DIR; + + return FR_OK; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Directory handling - Load/Store start cluster number */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +DWORD ld_clust ( + FATFS *fs, /* Pointer to the fs object */ + BYTE *dir /* Pointer to the directory entry */ +) +{ + DWORD cl; + + cl = LD_WORD(dir+DIR_FstClusLO); + if (fs->fs_type == FS_FAT32) + cl |= (DWORD)LD_WORD(dir+DIR_FstClusHI) << 16; + + return cl; +} + + +#if !_FS_READONLY +static +void st_clust ( + BYTE *dir, /* Pointer to the directory entry */ + DWORD cl /* Value to be set */ +) +{ + ST_WORD(dir+DIR_FstClusLO, cl); + ST_WORD(dir+DIR_FstClusHI, cl >> 16); +} +#endif + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* LFN handling - Test/Pick/Fit an LFN segment from/to directory entry */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _USE_LFN +static +const BYTE LfnOfs[] = {1,3,5,7,9,14,16,18,20,22,24,28,30}; /* Offset of LFN chars in the directory entry */ + + +static +int cmp_lfn ( /* 1:Matched, 0:Not matched */ + WCHAR *lfnbuf, /* Pointer to the LFN to be compared */ + BYTE *dir /* Pointer to the directory entry containing a part of LFN */ +) +{ + UINT i, s; + WCHAR wc, uc; + + + i = ((dir[LDIR_Ord] & ~LLE) - 1) * 13; /* Get offset in the LFN buffer */ + s = 0; wc = 1; + do { + uc = LD_WORD(dir+LfnOfs[s]); /* Pick an LFN character from the entry */ + if (wc) { /* Last char has not been processed */ + wc = ff_wtoupper(uc); /* Convert it to upper case */ + if (i >= _MAX_LFN || wc != ff_wtoupper(lfnbuf[i++])) /* Compare it */ + return 0; /* Not matched */ + } else { + if (uc != 0xFFFF) return 0; /* Check filler */ + } + } while (++s < 13); /* Repeat until all chars in the entry are checked */ + + if ((dir[LDIR_Ord] & LLE) && wc && lfnbuf[i]) /* Last segment matched but different length */ + return 0; + + return 1; /* The part of LFN matched */ +} + + + +static +int pick_lfn ( /* 1:Succeeded, 0:Buffer overflow */ + WCHAR *lfnbuf, /* Pointer to the Unicode-LFN buffer */ + BYTE *dir /* Pointer to the directory entry */ +) +{ + UINT i, s; + WCHAR wc, uc; + + + i = ((dir[LDIR_Ord] & 0x3F) - 1) * 13; /* Offset in the LFN buffer */ + + s = 0; wc = 1; + do { + uc = LD_WORD(dir+LfnOfs[s]); /* Pick an LFN character from the entry */ + if (wc) { /* Last char has not been processed */ + if (i >= _MAX_LFN) return 0; /* Buffer overflow? */ + lfnbuf[i++] = wc = uc; /* Store it */ + } else { + if (uc != 0xFFFF) return 0; /* Check filler */ + } + } while (++s < 13); /* Read all character in the entry */ + + if (dir[LDIR_Ord] & LLE) { /* Put terminator if it is the last LFN part */ + if (i >= _MAX_LFN) return 0; /* Buffer overflow? */ + lfnbuf[i] = 0; + } + + return 1; +} + + +#if !_FS_READONLY +static +void fit_lfn ( + const WCHAR *lfnbuf, /* Pointer to the LFN buffer */ + BYTE *dir, /* Pointer to the directory entry */ + BYTE ord, /* LFN order (1-20) */ + BYTE sum /* SFN sum */ +) +{ + UINT i, s; + WCHAR wc; + + + dir[LDIR_Chksum] = sum; /* Set check sum */ + dir[LDIR_Attr] = AM_LFN; /* Set attribute. LFN entry */ + dir[LDIR_Type] = 0; + ST_WORD(dir+LDIR_FstClusLO, 0); + + i = (ord - 1) * 13; /* Get offset in the LFN buffer */ + s = wc = 0; + do { + if (wc != 0xFFFF) wc = lfnbuf[i++]; /* Get an effective char */ + ST_WORD(dir+LfnOfs[s], wc); /* Put it */ + if (!wc) wc = 0xFFFF; /* Padding chars following last char */ + } while (++s < 13); + if (wc == 0xFFFF || !lfnbuf[i]) ord |= LLE; /* Bottom LFN part is the start of LFN sequence */ + dir[LDIR_Ord] = ord; /* Set the LFN order */ +} + +#endif +#endif + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Create numbered name */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _USE_LFN +void gen_numname ( + BYTE *dst, /* Pointer to generated SFN */ + const BYTE *src, /* Pointer to source SFN to be modified */ + const WCHAR *lfn, /* Pointer to LFN */ + WORD seq /* Sequence number */ +) +{ + BYTE ns[8], c; + UINT i, j; + + + mem_cpy(dst, src, 11); + + if (seq > 5) { /* On many collisions, generate a hash number instead of sequential number */ + do seq = (seq >> 1) + (seq << 15) + (WORD)*lfn++; while (*lfn); + } + + /* itoa (hexdecimal) */ + i = 7; + do { + c = (seq % 16) + '0'; + if (c > '9') c += 7; + ns[i--] = c; + seq /= 16; + } while (seq); + ns[i] = '~'; + + /* Append the number */ + for (j = 0; j < i && dst[j] != ' '; j++) { + if (IsDBCS1(dst[j])) { + if (j == i - 1) break; + j++; + } + } + do { + dst[j++] = (i < 8) ? ns[i++] : ' '; + } while (j < 8); +} +#endif + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Calculate sum of an SFN */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _USE_LFN +static +BYTE sum_sfn ( + const BYTE *dir /* Ptr to directory entry */ +) +{ + BYTE sum = 0; + UINT n = 11; + + do sum = (sum >> 1) + (sum << 7) + *dir++; while (--n); + return sum; +} +#endif + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Directory handling - Find an object in the directory */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT dir_find ( + DIR *dj /* Pointer to the directory object linked to the file name */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + BYTE c, *dir; +#if _USE_LFN + BYTE a, ord, sum; +#endif + + res = dir_sdi(dj, 0); /* Rewind directory object */ + if (res != FR_OK) return res; + +#if _USE_LFN + ord = sum = 0xFF; +#endif + do { + res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + dir = dj->dir; /* Ptr to the directory entry of current index */ + c = dir[DIR_Name]; + if (c == 0) { res = FR_NO_FILE; break; } /* Reached to end of table */ +#if _USE_LFN /* LFN configuration */ + a = dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_MASK; + if (c == DDE || ((a & AM_VOL) && a != AM_LFN)) { /* An entry without valid data */ + ord = 0xFF; + } else { + if (a == AM_LFN) { /* An LFN entry is found */ + if (dj->lfn) { + if (c & LLE) { /* Is it start of LFN sequence? */ + sum = dir[LDIR_Chksum]; + c &= ~LLE; ord = c; /* LFN start order */ + dj->lfn_idx = dj->index; + } + /* Check validity of the LFN entry and compare it with given name */ + ord = (c == ord && sum == dir[LDIR_Chksum] && cmp_lfn(dj->lfn, dir)) ? ord - 1 : 0xFF; + } + } else { /* An SFN entry is found */ + if (!ord && sum == sum_sfn(dir)) break; /* LFN matched? */ + ord = 0xFF; dj->lfn_idx = 0xFFFF; /* Reset LFN sequence */ + if (!(dj->fn[NS] & NS_LOSS) && !mem_cmp(dir, dj->fn, 11)) break; /* SFN matched? */ + } + } +#else /* Non LFN configuration */ + if (!(dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_VOL) && !mem_cmp(dir, dj->fn, 11)) /* Is it a valid entry? */ + break; +#endif + res = dir_next(dj, 0); /* Next entry */ + } while (res == FR_OK); + + return res; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Read an object from the directory */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _FS_MINIMIZE <= 1 +static +FRESULT dir_read ( + DIR *dj /* Pointer to the directory object that pointing the entry to be read */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + BYTE c, *dir; +#if _USE_LFN + BYTE a, ord = 0xFF, sum = 0xFF; +#endif + + res = FR_NO_FILE; + while (dj->sect) { + res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + dir = dj->dir; /* Ptr to the directory entry of current index */ + c = dir[DIR_Name]; + if (c == 0) { res = FR_NO_FILE; break; } /* Reached to end of table */ +#if _USE_LFN /* LFN configuration */ + a = dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_MASK; + if (c == DDE || (!_FS_RPATH && c == '.') || ((a & AM_VOL) && a != AM_LFN)) { /* An entry without valid data */ + ord = 0xFF; + } else { + if (a == AM_LFN) { /* An LFN entry is found */ + if (c & LLE) { /* Is it start of LFN sequence? */ + sum = dir[LDIR_Chksum]; + c &= ~LLE; ord = c; + dj->lfn_idx = dj->index; + } + /* Check LFN validity and capture it */ + ord = (c == ord && sum == dir[LDIR_Chksum] && pick_lfn(dj->lfn, dir)) ? ord - 1 : 0xFF; + } else { /* An SFN entry is found */ + if (ord || sum != sum_sfn(dir)) /* Is there a valid LFN? */ + dj->lfn_idx = 0xFFFF; /* It has no LFN. */ + break; + } + } +#else /* Non LFN configuration */ + if (c != DDE && (_FS_RPATH || c != '.') && !(dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_VOL)) /* Is it a valid entry? */ + break; +#endif + res = dir_next(dj, 0); /* Next entry */ + if (res != FR_OK) break; + } + + if (res != FR_OK) dj->sect = 0; + + return res; +} +#endif + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Register an object to the directory */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if !_FS_READONLY +static +FRESULT dir_register ( /* FR_OK:Successful, FR_DENIED:No free entry or too many SFN collision, FR_DISK_ERR:Disk error */ + DIR *dj /* Target directory with object name to be created */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + BYTE c, *dir; +#if _USE_LFN /* LFN configuration */ + WORD n, ne, is; + BYTE sn[12], *fn, sum; + WCHAR *lfn; + + + fn = dj->fn; lfn = dj->lfn; + mem_cpy(sn, fn, 12); + + if (_FS_RPATH && (sn[NS] & NS_DOT)) /* Cannot create dot entry */ + return FR_INVALID_NAME; + + if (sn[NS] & NS_LOSS) { /* When LFN is out of 8.3 format, generate a numbered name */ + fn[NS] = 0; dj->lfn = 0; /* Find only SFN */ + for (n = 1; n < 100; n++) { + gen_numname(fn, sn, lfn, n); /* Generate a numbered name */ + res = dir_find(dj); /* Check if the name collides with existing SFN */ + if (res != FR_OK) break; + } + if (n == 100) return FR_DENIED; /* Abort if too many collisions */ + if (res != FR_NO_FILE) return res; /* Abort if the result is other than 'not collided' */ + fn[NS] = sn[NS]; dj->lfn = lfn; + } + + if (sn[NS] & NS_LFN) { /* When LFN is to be created, reserve an SFN + LFN entries. */ + for (ne = 0; lfn[ne]; ne++) ; + ne = (ne + 25) / 13; + } else { /* Otherwise reserve only an SFN entry. */ + ne = 1; + } + + /* Reserve contiguous entries */ + res = dir_sdi(dj, 0); + if (res != FR_OK) return res; + n = is = 0; + do { + res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + c = *dj->dir; /* Check the entry status */ + if (c == DDE || c == 0) { /* Is it a blank entry? */ + if (n == 0) is = dj->index; /* First index of the contiguous entry */ + if (++n == ne) break; /* A contiguous entry that required count is found */ + } else { + n = 0; /* Not a blank entry. Restart to search */ + } + res = dir_next(dj, 1); /* Next entry with table stretch */ + } while (res == FR_OK); + + if (res == FR_OK && ne > 1) { /* Initialize LFN entry if needed */ + res = dir_sdi(dj, is); + if (res == FR_OK) { + sum = sum_sfn(dj->fn); /* Sum of the SFN tied to the LFN */ + ne--; + do { /* Store LFN entries in bottom first */ + res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + fit_lfn(dj->lfn, dj->dir, (BYTE)ne, sum); + dj->fs->wflag = 1; + res = dir_next(dj, 0); /* Next entry */ + } while (res == FR_OK && --ne); + } + } + +#else /* Non LFN configuration */ + res = dir_sdi(dj, 0); + if (res == FR_OK) { + do { /* Find a blank entry for the SFN */ + res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + c = *dj->dir; + if (c == DDE || c == 0) break; /* Is it a blank entry? */ + res = dir_next(dj, 1); /* Next entry with table stretch */ + } while (res == FR_OK); + } +#endif + + if (res == FR_OK) { /* Initialize the SFN entry */ + res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); + if (res == FR_OK) { + dir = dj->dir; + mem_set(dir, 0, SZ_DIR); /* Clean the entry */ + mem_cpy(dir, dj->fn, 11); /* Put SFN */ +#if _USE_LFN + dir[DIR_NTres] = *(dj->fn+NS) & (NS_BODY | NS_EXT); /* Put NT flag */ +#endif + dj->fs->wflag = 1; + } + } + + return res; +} +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Remove an object from the directory */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if !_FS_READONLY && !_FS_MINIMIZE +static +FRESULT dir_remove ( /* FR_OK: Successful, FR_DISK_ERR: A disk error */ + DIR *dj /* Directory object pointing the entry to be removed */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; +#if _USE_LFN /* LFN configuration */ + WORD i; + + i = dj->index; /* SFN index */ + res = dir_sdi(dj, (WORD)((dj->lfn_idx == 0xFFFF) ? i : dj->lfn_idx)); /* Goto the SFN or top of the LFN entries */ + if (res == FR_OK) { + do { + res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + *dj->dir = DDE; /* Mark the entry "deleted" */ + dj->fs->wflag = 1; + if (dj->index >= i) break; /* When reached SFN, all entries of the object has been deleted. */ + res = dir_next(dj, 0); /* Next entry */ + } while (res == FR_OK); + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) res = FR_INT_ERR; + } + +#else /* Non LFN configuration */ + res = dir_sdi(dj, dj->index); + if (res == FR_OK) { + res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); + if (res == FR_OK) { + *dj->dir = DDE; /* Mark the entry "deleted" */ + dj->fs->wflag = 1; + } + } +#endif + + return res; +} +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Pick a segment and create the object name in directory form */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT create_name ( + DIR *dj, /* Pointer to the directory object */ + const TCHAR **path /* Pointer to pointer to the segment in the path string */ +) +{ +#ifdef _EXCVT + static const BYTE excvt[] = _EXCVT; /* Upper conversion table for extended chars */ +#endif + +#if _USE_LFN /* LFN configuration */ + BYTE b, cf; + WCHAR w, *lfn; + UINT i, ni, si, di; + const TCHAR *p; + + /* Create LFN in Unicode */ + for (p = *path; *p == '/' || *p == '\\'; p++) ; /* Strip duplicated separator */ + lfn = dj->lfn; + si = di = 0; + for (;;) { + w = p[si++]; /* Get a character */ + if (w < ' ' || w == '/' || w == '\\') break; /* Break on end of segment */ + if (di >= _MAX_LFN) /* Reject too long name */ + return FR_INVALID_NAME; +#if !_LFN_UNICODE + w &= 0xFF; + if (IsDBCS1(w)) { /* Check if it is a DBC 1st byte (always false on SBCS cfg) */ + b = (BYTE)p[si++]; /* Get 2nd byte */ + if (!IsDBCS2(b)) + return FR_INVALID_NAME; /* Reject invalid sequence */ + w = (w << 8) + b; /* Create a DBC */ + } + w = ff_convert(w, 1); /* Convert ANSI/OEM to Unicode */ + if (!w) return FR_INVALID_NAME; /* Reject invalid code */ +#endif + if (w < 0x80 && chk_chr("\"*:<>\?|\x7F", w)) /* Reject illegal chars for LFN */ + return FR_INVALID_NAME; + lfn[di++] = w; /* Store the Unicode char */ + } + *path = &p[si]; /* Return pointer to the next segment */ + cf = (w < ' ') ? NS_LAST : 0; /* Set last segment flag if end of path */ +#if _FS_RPATH + if ((di == 1 && lfn[di-1] == '.') || /* Is this a dot entry? */ + (di == 2 && lfn[di-1] == '.' && lfn[di-2] == '.')) { + lfn[di] = 0; + for (i = 0; i < 11; i++) + dj->fn[i] = (i < di) ? '.' : ' '; + dj->fn[i] = cf | NS_DOT; /* This is a dot entry */ + return FR_OK; + } +#endif + while (di) { /* Strip trailing spaces and dots */ + w = lfn[di-1]; + if (w != ' ' && w != '.') break; + di--; + } + if (!di) return FR_INVALID_NAME; /* Reject nul string */ + + lfn[di] = 0; /* LFN is created */ + + /* Create SFN in directory form */ + mem_set(dj->fn, ' ', 11); + for (si = 0; lfn[si] == ' ' || lfn[si] == '.'; si++) ; /* Strip leading spaces and dots */ + if (si) cf |= NS_LOSS | NS_LFN; + while (di && lfn[di - 1] != '.') di--; /* Find extension (di<=si: no extension) */ + + b = i = 0; ni = 8; + for (;;) { + w = lfn[si++]; /* Get an LFN char */ + if (!w) break; /* Break on end of the LFN */ + if (w == ' ' || (w == '.' && si != di)) { /* Remove spaces and dots */ + cf |= NS_LOSS | NS_LFN; continue; + } + + if (i >= ni || si == di) { /* Extension or end of SFN */ + if (ni == 11) { /* Long extension */ + cf |= NS_LOSS | NS_LFN; break; + } + if (si != di) cf |= NS_LOSS | NS_LFN; /* Out of 8.3 format */ + if (si > di) break; /* No extension */ + si = di; i = 8; ni = 11; /* Enter extension section */ + b <<= 2; continue; + } + + if (w >= 0x80) { /* Non ASCII char */ +#ifdef _EXCVT + w = ff_convert(w, 0); /* Unicode -> OEM code */ + if (w) w = excvt[w - 0x80]; /* Convert extended char to upper (SBCS) */ +#else + w = ff_convert(ff_wtoupper(w), 0); /* Upper converted Unicode -> OEM code */ +#endif + cf |= NS_LFN; /* Force create LFN entry */ + } + + if (_DF1S && w >= 0x100) { /* Double byte char (always false on SBCS cfg) */ + if (i >= ni - 1) { + cf |= NS_LOSS | NS_LFN; i = ni; continue; + } + dj->fn[i++] = (BYTE)(w >> 8); + } else { /* Single byte char */ + if (!w || chk_chr("+,;=[]", w)) { /* Replace illegal chars for SFN */ + w = '_'; cf |= NS_LOSS | NS_LFN;/* Lossy conversion */ + } else { + if (IsUpper(w)) { /* ASCII large capital */ + b |= 2; + } else { + if (IsLower(w)) { /* ASCII small capital */ + b |= 1; w -= 0x20; + } + } + } + } + dj->fn[i++] = (BYTE)w; + } + + if (dj->fn[0] == DDE) dj->fn[0] = NDDE; /* If the first char collides with deleted mark, replace it with 0x05 */ + + if (ni == 8) b <<= 2; + if ((b & 0x0C) == 0x0C || (b & 0x03) == 0x03) /* Create LFN entry when there are composite capitals */ + cf |= NS_LFN; + if (!(cf & NS_LFN)) { /* When LFN is in 8.3 format without extended char, NT flags are created */ + if ((b & 0x03) == 0x01) cf |= NS_EXT; /* NT flag (Extension has only small capital) */ + if ((b & 0x0C) == 0x04) cf |= NS_BODY; /* NT flag (Filename has only small capital) */ + } + + dj->fn[NS] = cf; /* SFN is created */ + + return FR_OK; + + +#else /* Non-LFN configuration */ + BYTE b, c, d, *sfn; + UINT ni, si, i; + const char *p; + + /* Create file name in directory form */ + for (p = *path; *p == '/' || *p == '\\'; p++) ; /* Strip duplicated separator */ + sfn = dj->fn; + mem_set(sfn, ' ', 11); + si = i = b = 0; ni = 8; +#if _FS_RPATH + if (p[si] == '.') { /* Is this a dot entry? */ + for (;;) { + c = (BYTE)p[si++]; + if (c != '.' || si >= 3) break; + sfn[i++] = c; + } + if (c != '/' && c != '\\' && c > ' ') return FR_INVALID_NAME; + *path = &p[si]; /* Return pointer to the next segment */ + sfn[NS] = (c <= ' ') ? NS_LAST | NS_DOT : NS_DOT; /* Set last segment flag if end of path */ + return FR_OK; + } +#endif + for (;;) { + c = (BYTE)p[si++]; + if (c <= ' ' || c == '/' || c == '\\') break; /* Break on end of segment */ + if (c == '.' || i >= ni) { + if (ni != 8 || c != '.') return FR_INVALID_NAME; + i = 8; ni = 11; + b <<= 2; continue; + } + if (c >= 0x80) { /* Extended char? */ + b |= 3; /* Eliminate NT flag */ +#ifdef _EXCVT + c = excvt[c - 0x80]; /* Upper conversion (SBCS) */ +#else +#if !_DF1S /* ASCII only cfg */ + return FR_INVALID_NAME; +#endif +#endif + } + if (IsDBCS1(c)) { /* Check if it is a DBC 1st byte (always false on SBCS cfg) */ + d = (BYTE)p[si++]; /* Get 2nd byte */ + if (!IsDBCS2(d) || i >= ni - 1) /* Reject invalid DBC */ + return FR_INVALID_NAME; + sfn[i++] = c; + sfn[i++] = d; + } else { /* Single byte code */ + if (chk_chr("\"*+,:;<=>\?[]|\x7F", c)) /* Reject illegal chrs for SFN */ + return FR_INVALID_NAME; + if (IsUpper(c)) { /* ASCII large capital? */ + b |= 2; + } else { + if (IsLower(c)) { /* ASCII small capital? */ + b |= 1; c -= 0x20; + } + } + sfn[i++] = c; + } + } + *path = &p[si]; /* Return pointer to the next segment */ + c = (c <= ' ') ? NS_LAST : 0; /* Set last segment flag if end of path */ + + if (!i) return FR_INVALID_NAME; /* Reject nul string */ + if (sfn[0] == DDE) sfn[0] = NDDE; /* When first char collides with DDE, replace it with 0x05 */ + + if (ni == 8) b <<= 2; + if ((b & 0x03) == 0x01) c |= NS_EXT; /* NT flag (Name extension has only small capital) */ + if ((b & 0x0C) == 0x04) c |= NS_BODY; /* NT flag (Name body has only small capital) */ + + sfn[NS] = c; /* Store NT flag, File name is created */ + + return FR_OK; +#endif +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Get file information from directory entry */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _FS_MINIMIZE <= 1 +static +void get_fileinfo ( /* No return code */ + DIR *dj, /* Pointer to the directory object */ + FILINFO *fno /* Pointer to the file information to be filled */ +) +{ + UINT i; + BYTE nt, *dir; + TCHAR *p, c; + + + p = fno->fname; + if (dj->sect) { + dir = dj->dir; + nt = dir[DIR_NTres]; /* NT flag */ + for (i = 0; i < 8; i++) { /* Copy name body */ + c = dir[i]; + if (c == ' ') break; + if (c == NDDE) c = (TCHAR)DDE; + if (_USE_LFN && (nt & NS_BODY) && IsUpper(c)) c += 0x20; +#if _LFN_UNICODE + if (IsDBCS1(c) && i < 7 && IsDBCS2(dir[i+1])) + c = (c << 8) | dir[++i]; + c = ff_convert(c, 1); + if (!c) c = '?'; +#endif + *p++ = c; + } + if (dir[8] != ' ') { /* Copy name extension */ + *p++ = '.'; + for (i = 8; i < 11; i++) { + c = dir[i]; + if (c == ' ') break; + if (_USE_LFN && (nt & NS_EXT) && IsUpper(c)) c += 0x20; +#if _LFN_UNICODE + if (IsDBCS1(c) && i < 10 && IsDBCS2(dir[i+1])) + c = (c << 8) | dir[++i]; + c = ff_convert(c, 1); + if (!c) c = '?'; +#endif + *p++ = c; + } + } + fno->fattrib = dir[DIR_Attr]; /* Attribute */ + fno->fsize = LD_DWORD(dir+DIR_FileSize); /* Size */ + fno->fdate = LD_WORD(dir+DIR_WrtDate); /* Date */ + fno->ftime = LD_WORD(dir+DIR_WrtTime); /* Time */ + } + *p = 0; /* Terminate SFN str by a \0 */ + +#if _USE_LFN + if (fno->lfname && fno->lfsize) { + TCHAR *tp = fno->lfname; + WCHAR w, *lfn; + + i = 0; + if (dj->sect && dj->lfn_idx != 0xFFFF) {/* Get LFN if available */ + lfn = dj->lfn; + while ((w = *lfn++) != 0) { /* Get an LFN char */ +#if !_LFN_UNICODE + w = ff_convert(w, 0); /* Unicode -> OEM conversion */ + if (!w) { i = 0; break; } /* Could not convert, no LFN */ + if (_DF1S && w >= 0x100) /* Put 1st byte if it is a DBC (always false on SBCS cfg) */ + tp[i++] = (TCHAR)(w >> 8); +#endif + if (i >= fno->lfsize - 1) { i = 0; break; } /* Buffer overflow, no LFN */ + tp[i++] = (TCHAR)w; + } + } + tp[i] = 0; /* Terminate the LFN str by a \0 */ + } +#endif +} +#endif /* _FS_MINIMIZE <= 1 */ + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Follow a file path */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT follow_path ( /* FR_OK(0): successful, !=0: error code */ + DIR *dj, /* Directory object to return last directory and found object */ + const TCHAR *path /* Full-path string to find a file or directory */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + BYTE *dir, ns; + + +#if _FS_RPATH + if (*path == '/' || *path == '\\') { /* There is a heading separator */ + path++; dj->sclust = 0; /* Strip it and start from the root dir */ + } else { /* No heading separator */ + dj->sclust = dj->fs->cdir; /* Start from the current dir */ + } +#else + if (*path == '/' || *path == '\\') /* Strip heading separator if exist */ + path++; + dj->sclust = 0; /* Start from the root dir */ +#endif + + if ((UINT)*path < ' ') { /* Nul path means the start directory itself */ + res = dir_sdi(dj, 0); + dj->dir = 0; + } else { /* Follow path */ + for (;;) { + res = create_name(dj, &path); /* Get a segment */ + if (res != FR_OK) break; + res = dir_find(dj); /* Find it */ + ns = *(dj->fn+NS); + if (res != FR_OK) { /* Failed to find the object */ + if (res != FR_NO_FILE) break; /* Abort if any hard error occurred */ + /* Object not found */ + if (_FS_RPATH && (ns & NS_DOT)) { /* If dot entry is not exit */ + dj->sclust = 0; dj->dir = 0; /* It is the root dir */ + res = FR_OK; + if (!(ns & NS_LAST)) continue; + } else { /* Could not find the object */ + if (!(ns & NS_LAST)) res = FR_NO_PATH; + } + break; + } + if (ns & NS_LAST) break; /* Last segment match. Function completed. */ + dir = dj->dir; /* There is next segment. Follow the sub directory */ + if (!(dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR)) { /* Cannot follow because it is a file */ + res = FR_NO_PATH; break; + } + dj->sclust = ld_clust(dj->fs, dir); + } + } + + return res; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Load a sector and check if it is an FAT Volume Boot Record */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +BYTE check_fs ( /* 0:FAT-VBR, 1:Any BR but not FAT, 2:Not a BR, 3:Disk error */ + FATFS *fs, /* File system object */ + DWORD sect /* Sector# (lba) to check if it is an FAT boot record or not */ +) +{ + if (disk_read(fs->drv, fs->win, sect, 1) != RES_OK) /* Load boot record */ + return 3; + if (LD_WORD(&fs->win[BS_55AA]) != 0xAA55) /* Check record signature (always placed at offset 510 even if the sector size is >512) */ + return 2; + + if ((LD_DWORD(&fs->win[BS_FilSysType]) & 0xFFFFFF) == 0x544146) /* Check "FAT" string */ + return 0; + if ((LD_DWORD(&fs->win[BS_FilSysType32]) & 0xFFFFFF) == 0x544146) + return 0; + + return 1; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Check if the file system object is valid or not */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT chk_mounted ( /* FR_OK(0): successful, !=0: any error occurred */ + const TCHAR **path, /* Pointer to pointer to the path name (drive number) */ + FATFS **rfs, /* Pointer to pointer to the found file system object */ + BYTE wmode /* !=0: Check write protection for write access */ +) +{ + BYTE fmt, b, pi, *tbl; + UINT vol; + DSTATUS stat; + DWORD bsect, fasize, tsect, sysect, nclst, szbfat; + WORD nrsv; + const TCHAR *p = *path; + FATFS *fs; + + + /* Get logical drive number from the path name */ + vol = p[0] - '0'; /* Is there a drive number? */ + if (vol <= 9 && p[1] == ':') { /* Found a drive number, get and strip it */ + p += 2; *path = p; /* Return pointer to the path name */ + } else { /* No drive number is given */ +#if _FS_RPATH + vol = CurrVol; /* Use current drive */ +#else + vol = 0; /* Use drive 0 */ +#endif + } + + /* Check if the file system object is valid or not */ + *rfs = 0; + if (vol >= _VOLUMES) /* Is the drive number valid? */ + return FR_INVALID_DRIVE; + fs = FatFs[vol]; /* Get corresponding file system object */ + if (!fs) return FR_NOT_ENABLED; /* Is the file system object available? */ + + ENTER_FF(fs); /* Lock file system */ + + *rfs = fs; /* Return pointer to the corresponding file system object */ + if (fs->fs_type) { /* If the volume has been mounted */ + stat = disk_status(fs->drv); + if (!(stat & STA_NOINIT)) { /* and the physical drive is kept initialized (has not been changed), */ + if (!_FS_READONLY && wmode && (stat & STA_PROTECT)) /* Check write protection if needed */ + return FR_WRITE_PROTECTED; + return FR_OK; /* The file system object is valid */ + } + } + + /* The file system object is not valid. */ + /* Following code attempts to mount the volume. (analyze BPB and initialize the fs object) */ + + fs->fs_type = 0; /* Clear the file system object */ + fs->drv = LD2PD(vol); /* Bind the logical drive and a physical drive */ + stat = disk_initialize(fs->drv); /* Initialize the physical drive */ + if (stat & STA_NOINIT) /* Check if the initialization succeeded */ + return FR_NOT_READY; /* Failed to initialize due to no medium or hard error */ + if (!_FS_READONLY && wmode && (stat & STA_PROTECT)) /* Check disk write protection if needed */ + return FR_WRITE_PROTECTED; +#if _MAX_SS != 512 /* Get disk sector size (variable sector size cfg only) */ + if (disk_ioctl(fs->drv, GET_SECTOR_SIZE, &fs->ssize) != RES_OK) + return FR_DISK_ERR; +#endif + /* Search FAT partition on the drive. Supports only generic partitions, FDISK and SFD. */ + fmt = check_fs(fs, bsect = 0); /* Load sector 0 and check if it is an FAT-VBR (in SFD) */ + if (LD2PT(vol) && !fmt) fmt = 1; /* Force non-SFD if the volume is forced partition */ + if (fmt == 1) { /* Not an FAT-VBR, the physical drive can be partitioned */ + /* Check the partition listed in the partition table */ + pi = LD2PT(vol); + if (pi) pi--; + tbl = &fs->win[MBR_Table + pi * SZ_PTE];/* Partition table */ + if (tbl[4]) { /* Is the partition existing? */ + bsect = LD_DWORD(&tbl[8]); /* Partition offset in LBA */ + fmt = check_fs(fs, bsect); /* Check the partition */ + } + } + if (fmt == 3) return FR_DISK_ERR; + if (fmt) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; /* No FAT volume is found */ + + /* An FAT volume is found. Following code initializes the file system object */ + + if (LD_WORD(fs->win+BPB_BytsPerSec) != SS(fs)) /* (BPB_BytsPerSec must be equal to the physical sector size) */ + return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; + + fasize = LD_WORD(fs->win+BPB_FATSz16); /* Number of sectors per FAT */ + if (!fasize) fasize = LD_DWORD(fs->win+BPB_FATSz32); + fs->fsize = fasize; + + fs->n_fats = b = fs->win[BPB_NumFATs]; /* Number of FAT copies */ + if (b != 1 && b != 2) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; /* (Must be 1 or 2) */ + fasize *= b; /* Number of sectors for FAT area */ + + fs->csize = b = fs->win[BPB_SecPerClus]; /* Number of sectors per cluster */ + if (!b || (b & (b - 1))) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; /* (Must be power of 2) */ + + fs->n_rootdir = LD_WORD(fs->win+BPB_RootEntCnt); /* Number of root directory entries */ + if (fs->n_rootdir % (SS(fs) / SZ_DIR)) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; /* (BPB_RootEntCnt must be sector aligned) */ + + tsect = LD_WORD(fs->win+BPB_TotSec16); /* Number of sectors on the volume */ + if (!tsect) tsect = LD_DWORD(fs->win+BPB_TotSec32); + + nrsv = LD_WORD(fs->win+BPB_RsvdSecCnt); /* Number of reserved sectors */ + if (!nrsv) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; /* (BPB_RsvdSecCnt must not be 0) */ + + /* Determine the FAT sub type */ + sysect = nrsv + fasize + fs->n_rootdir / (SS(fs) / SZ_DIR); /* RSV+FAT+DIR */ + if (tsect < sysect) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; /* (Invalid volume size) */ + nclst = (tsect - sysect) / fs->csize; /* Number of clusters */ + if (!nclst) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; /* (Invalid volume size) */ + fmt = FS_FAT12; + if (nclst >= MIN_FAT16) fmt = FS_FAT16; + if (nclst >= MIN_FAT32) fmt = FS_FAT32; + + /* Boundaries and Limits */ + fs->n_fatent = nclst + 2; /* Number of FAT entries */ + fs->database = bsect + sysect; /* Data start sector */ + fs->fatbase = bsect + nrsv; /* FAT start sector */ + if (fmt == FS_FAT32) { + if (fs->n_rootdir) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; /* (BPB_RootEntCnt must be 0) */ + fs->dirbase = LD_DWORD(fs->win+BPB_RootClus); /* Root directory start cluster */ + szbfat = fs->n_fatent * 4; /* (Required FAT size) */ + } else { + if (!fs->n_rootdir) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; /* (BPB_RootEntCnt must not be 0) */ + fs->dirbase = fs->fatbase + fasize; /* Root directory start sector */ + szbfat = (fmt == FS_FAT16) ? /* (Required FAT size) */ + fs->n_fatent * 2 : fs->n_fatent * 3 / 2 + (fs->n_fatent & 1); + } + if (fs->fsize < (szbfat + (SS(fs) - 1)) / SS(fs)) /* (BPB_FATSz must not be less than required) */ + return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; + +#if !_FS_READONLY + /* Initialize cluster allocation information */ + fs->free_clust = 0xFFFFFFFF; + fs->last_clust = 0; + + /* Get fsinfo if available */ + if (fmt == FS_FAT32) { + fs->fsi_flag = 0; + fs->fsi_sector = bsect + LD_WORD(fs->win+BPB_FSInfo); + if (disk_read(fs->drv, fs->win, fs->fsi_sector, 1) == RES_OK && + LD_WORD(fs->win+BS_55AA) == 0xAA55 && + LD_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_LeadSig) == 0x41615252 && + LD_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_StrucSig) == 0x61417272) { + fs->last_clust = LD_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_Nxt_Free); + fs->free_clust = LD_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_Free_Count); + } + } +#endif + fs->fs_type = fmt; /* FAT sub-type */ + fs->id = ++Fsid; /* File system mount ID */ + fs->winsect = 0; /* Invalidate sector cache */ + fs->wflag = 0; +#if _FS_RPATH + fs->cdir = 0; /* Current directory (root dir) */ +#endif +#if _FS_LOCK /* Clear file lock semaphores */ + clear_lock(fs); +#endif + + return FR_OK; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Check if the file/dir object is valid or not */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT validate ( /* FR_OK(0): The object is valid, !=0: Invalid */ + void* obj /* Pointer to the object FIL/DIR to check validity */ +) +{ + FIL *fil; + + + fil = (FIL*)obj; /* Assuming offset of fs and id in the FIL/DIR is identical */ + if (!fil->fs || !fil->fs->fs_type || fil->fs->id != fil->id) + return FR_INVALID_OBJECT; + + ENTER_FF(fil->fs); /* Lock file system */ + + if (disk_status(fil->fs->drv) & STA_NOINIT) + return FR_NOT_READY; + + return FR_OK; +} + + + + +/*-------------------------------------------------------------------------- + + Public Functions + +--------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Mount/Unmount a Logical Drive */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_mount ( + BYTE vol, /* Logical drive number to be mounted/unmounted */ + FATFS *fs /* Pointer to new file system object (NULL for unmount)*/ +) +{ + FATFS *rfs; + + + if (vol >= _VOLUMES) /* Check if the drive number is valid */ + return FR_INVALID_DRIVE; + rfs = FatFs[vol]; /* Get current fs object */ + + if (rfs) { +#if _FS_LOCK + clear_lock(rfs); +#endif +#if _FS_REENTRANT /* Discard sync object of the current volume */ + if (!ff_del_syncobj(rfs->sobj)) return FR_INT_ERR; +#endif + rfs->fs_type = 0; /* Clear old fs object */ + } + + if (fs) { + fs->fs_type = 0; /* Clear new fs object */ +#if _FS_REENTRANT /* Create sync object for the new volume */ + if (!ff_cre_syncobj(vol, &fs->sobj)) return FR_INT_ERR; +#endif + } + FatFs[vol] = fs; /* Register new fs object */ + + return FR_OK; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Open or Create a File */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_open ( + FIL *fp, /* Pointer to the blank file object */ + const TCHAR *path, /* Pointer to the file name */ + BYTE mode /* Access mode and file open mode flags */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DIR dj; + BYTE *dir; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + if (!fp) return FR_INVALID_OBJECT; + fp->fs = 0; /* Clear file object */ + +#if !_FS_READONLY + mode &= FA_READ | FA_WRITE | FA_CREATE_ALWAYS | FA_OPEN_ALWAYS | FA_CREATE_NEW; + res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, (BYTE)(mode & ~FA_READ)); +#else + mode &= FA_READ; + res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 0); +#endif + if (res == FR_OK) { + INIT_BUF(dj); + res = follow_path(&dj, path); /* Follow the file path */ + dir = dj.dir; +#if !_FS_READONLY /* R/W configuration */ + if (res == FR_OK) { + if (!dir) /* Current dir itself */ + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; +#if _FS_LOCK + else + res = chk_lock(&dj, (mode & ~FA_READ) ? 1 : 0); +#endif + } + /* Create or Open a file */ + if (mode & (FA_CREATE_ALWAYS | FA_OPEN_ALWAYS | FA_CREATE_NEW)) { + DWORD dw, cl; + + if (res != FR_OK) { /* No file, create new */ + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) /* There is no file to open, create a new entry */ +#if _FS_LOCK + res = enq_lock() ? dir_register(&dj) : FR_TOO_MANY_OPEN_FILES; +#else + res = dir_register(&dj); +#endif + mode |= FA_CREATE_ALWAYS; /* File is created */ + dir = dj.dir; /* New entry */ + } + else { /* Any object is already existing */ + if (dir[DIR_Attr] & (AM_RDO | AM_DIR)) { /* Cannot overwrite it (R/O or DIR) */ + res = FR_DENIED; + } else { + if (mode & FA_CREATE_NEW) /* Cannot create as new file */ + res = FR_EXIST; + } + } + if (res == FR_OK && (mode & FA_CREATE_ALWAYS)) { /* Truncate it if overwrite mode */ + dw = get_fattime(); /* Created time */ + ST_DWORD(dir+DIR_CrtTime, dw); + dir[DIR_Attr] = 0; /* Reset attribute */ + ST_DWORD(dir+DIR_FileSize, 0); /* size = 0 */ + cl = ld_clust(dj.fs, dir); /* Get start cluster */ + st_clust(dir, 0); /* cluster = 0 */ + dj.fs->wflag = 1; + if (cl) { /* Remove the cluster chain if exist */ + dw = dj.fs->winsect; + res = remove_chain(dj.fs, cl); + if (res == FR_OK) { + dj.fs->last_clust = cl - 1; /* Reuse the cluster hole */ + res = move_window(dj.fs, dw); + } + } + } + } + else { /* Open an existing file */ + if (res == FR_OK) { /* Follow succeeded */ + if (dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR) { /* It is a directory */ + res = FR_NO_FILE; + } else { + if ((mode & FA_WRITE) && (dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_RDO)) /* R/O violation */ + res = FR_DENIED; + } + } + } + if (res == FR_OK) { + if (mode & FA_CREATE_ALWAYS) /* Set file change flag if created or overwritten */ + mode |= FA__WRITTEN; + fp->dir_sect = dj.fs->winsect; /* Pointer to the directory entry */ + fp->dir_ptr = dir; +#if _FS_LOCK + fp->lockid = inc_lock(&dj, (mode & ~FA_READ) ? 1 : 0); + if (!fp->lockid) res = FR_INT_ERR; +#endif + } + +#else /* R/O configuration */ + if (res == FR_OK) { /* Follow succeeded */ + dir = dj.dir; + if (!dir) { /* Current dir itself */ + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; + } else { + if (dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR) /* It is a directory */ + res = FR_NO_FILE; + } + } +#endif + FREE_BUF(); + + if (res == FR_OK) { + fp->flag = mode; /* File access mode */ + fp->sclust = ld_clust(dj.fs, dir); /* File start cluster */ + fp->fsize = LD_DWORD(dir+DIR_FileSize); /* File size */ + fp->fptr = 0; /* File pointer */ + fp->dsect = 0; +#if _USE_FASTSEEK + fp->cltbl = 0; /* Normal seek mode */ +#endif + fp->fs = dj.fs; fp->id = dj.fs->id; /* Validate file object */ + } + } + + LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Read File */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_read ( + FIL *fp, /* Pointer to the file object */ + void *buff, /* Pointer to data buffer */ + UINT btr, /* Number of bytes to read */ + UINT *br /* Pointer to number of bytes read */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DWORD clst, sect, remain; + UINT rcnt, cc; + BYTE csect, *rbuff = buff; + + + *br = 0; /* Clear read byte counter */ + + res = validate(fp); /* Check validity */ + if (res != FR_OK) LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); + if (fp->flag & FA__ERROR) /* Aborted file? */ + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + if (!(fp->flag & FA_READ)) /* Check access mode */ + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_DENIED); + remain = fp->fsize - fp->fptr; + if (btr > remain) btr = (UINT)remain; /* Truncate btr by remaining bytes */ + + for ( ; btr; /* Repeat until all data read */ + rbuff += rcnt, fp->fptr += rcnt, *br += rcnt, btr -= rcnt) { + if ((fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)) == 0) { /* On the sector boundary? */ + csect = (BYTE)(fp->fptr / SS(fp->fs) & (fp->fs->csize - 1)); /* Sector offset in the cluster */ + if (!csect) { /* On the cluster boundary? */ + if (fp->fptr == 0) { /* On the top of the file? */ + clst = fp->sclust; /* Follow from the origin */ + } else { /* Middle or end of the file */ +#if _USE_FASTSEEK + if (fp->cltbl) + clst = clmt_clust(fp, fp->fptr); /* Get cluster# from the CLMT */ + else +#endif + clst = get_fat(fp->fs, fp->clust); /* Follow cluster chain on the FAT */ + } + if (clst < 2) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->clust = clst; /* Update current cluster */ + } + sect = clust2sect(fp->fs, fp->clust); /* Get current sector */ + if (!sect) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + sect += csect; + cc = btr / SS(fp->fs); /* When remaining bytes >= sector size, */ + if (cc) { /* Read maximum contiguous sectors directly */ + if (csect + cc > fp->fs->csize) /* Clip at cluster boundary */ + cc = fp->fs->csize - csect; + if (disk_read(fp->fs->drv, rbuff, sect, (BYTE)cc) != RES_OK) + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +#if !_FS_READONLY && _FS_MINIMIZE <= 2 /* Replace one of the read sectors with cached data if it contains a dirty sector */ +#if _FS_TINY + if (fp->fs->wflag && fp->fs->winsect - sect < cc) + mem_cpy(rbuff + ((fp->fs->winsect - sect) * SS(fp->fs)), fp->fs->win, SS(fp->fs)); +#else + if ((fp->flag & FA__DIRTY) && fp->dsect - sect < cc) + mem_cpy(rbuff + ((fp->dsect - sect) * SS(fp->fs)), fp->buf, SS(fp->fs)); +#endif +#endif + rcnt = SS(fp->fs) * cc; /* Number of bytes transferred */ + continue; + } +#if !_FS_TINY + if (fp->dsect != sect) { /* Load data sector if not in cache */ +#if !_FS_READONLY + if (fp->flag & FA__DIRTY) { /* Write-back dirty sector cache */ + if (disk_write(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, fp->dsect, 1) != RES_OK) + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->flag &= ~FA__DIRTY; + } +#endif + if (disk_read(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, sect, 1) != RES_OK) /* Fill sector cache */ + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + } +#endif + fp->dsect = sect; + } + rcnt = SS(fp->fs) - ((UINT)fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)); /* Get partial sector data from sector buffer */ + if (rcnt > btr) rcnt = btr; +#if _FS_TINY + if (move_window(fp->fs, fp->dsect)) /* Move sector window */ + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + mem_cpy(rbuff, &fp->fs->win[fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)], rcnt); /* Pick partial sector */ +#else + mem_cpy(rbuff, &fp->buf[fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)], rcnt); /* Pick partial sector */ +#endif + } + + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_OK); +} + + + + +#if !_FS_READONLY +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Write File */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_write ( + FIL *fp, /* Pointer to the file object */ + const void *buff, /* Pointer to the data to be written */ + UINT btw, /* Number of bytes to write */ + UINT *bw /* Pointer to number of bytes written */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DWORD clst, sect; + UINT wcnt, cc; + const BYTE *wbuff = buff; + BYTE csect; + + + *bw = 0; /* Clear write byte counter */ + + res = validate(fp); /* Check validity */ + if (res != FR_OK) LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); + if (fp->flag & FA__ERROR) /* Aborted file? */ + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + if (!(fp->flag & FA_WRITE)) /* Check access mode */ + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_DENIED); + if ((DWORD)(fp->fsize + btw) < fp->fsize) btw = 0; /* File size cannot reach 4GB */ + + for ( ; btw; /* Repeat until all data written */ + wbuff += wcnt, fp->fptr += wcnt, *bw += wcnt, btw -= wcnt) { + if ((fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)) == 0) { /* On the sector boundary? */ + csect = (BYTE)(fp->fptr / SS(fp->fs) & (fp->fs->csize - 1)); /* Sector offset in the cluster */ + if (!csect) { /* On the cluster boundary? */ + if (fp->fptr == 0) { /* On the top of the file? */ + clst = fp->sclust; /* Follow from the origin */ + if (clst == 0) /* When no cluster is allocated, */ + fp->sclust = clst = create_chain(fp->fs, 0); /* Create a new cluster chain */ + } else { /* Middle or end of the file */ +#if _USE_FASTSEEK + if (fp->cltbl) + clst = clmt_clust(fp, fp->fptr); /* Get cluster# from the CLMT */ + else +#endif + clst = create_chain(fp->fs, fp->clust); /* Follow or stretch cluster chain on the FAT */ + } + if (clst == 0) break; /* Could not allocate a new cluster (disk full) */ + if (clst == 1) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->clust = clst; /* Update current cluster */ + } +#if _FS_TINY + if (fp->fs->winsect == fp->dsect && move_window(fp->fs, 0)) /* Write-back sector cache */ + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +#else + if (fp->flag & FA__DIRTY) { /* Write-back sector cache */ + if (disk_write(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, fp->dsect, 1) != RES_OK) + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->flag &= ~FA__DIRTY; + } +#endif + sect = clust2sect(fp->fs, fp->clust); /* Get current sector */ + if (!sect) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + sect += csect; + cc = btw / SS(fp->fs); /* When remaining bytes >= sector size, */ + if (cc) { /* Write maximum contiguous sectors directly */ + if (csect + cc > fp->fs->csize) /* Clip at cluster boundary */ + cc = fp->fs->csize - csect; + if (disk_write(fp->fs->drv, wbuff, sect, (BYTE)cc) != RES_OK) + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +#if _FS_TINY + if (fp->fs->winsect - sect < cc) { /* Refill sector cache if it gets invalidated by the direct write */ + mem_cpy(fp->fs->win, wbuff + ((fp->fs->winsect - sect) * SS(fp->fs)), SS(fp->fs)); + fp->fs->wflag = 0; + } +#else + if (fp->dsect - sect < cc) { /* Refill sector cache if it gets invalidated by the direct write */ + mem_cpy(fp->buf, wbuff + ((fp->dsect - sect) * SS(fp->fs)), SS(fp->fs)); + fp->flag &= ~FA__DIRTY; + } +#endif + wcnt = SS(fp->fs) * cc; /* Number of bytes transferred */ + continue; + } +#if _FS_TINY + if (fp->fptr >= fp->fsize) { /* Avoid silly cache filling at growing edge */ + if (move_window(fp->fs, 0)) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->fs->winsect = sect; + } +#else + if (fp->dsect != sect) { /* Fill sector cache with file data */ + if (fp->fptr < fp->fsize && + disk_read(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, sect, 1) != RES_OK) + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + } +#endif + fp->dsect = sect; + } + wcnt = SS(fp->fs) - ((UINT)fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs));/* Put partial sector into file I/O buffer */ + if (wcnt > btw) wcnt = btw; +#if _FS_TINY + if (move_window(fp->fs, fp->dsect)) /* Move sector window */ + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + mem_cpy(&fp->fs->win[fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)], wbuff, wcnt); /* Fit partial sector */ + fp->fs->wflag = 1; +#else + mem_cpy(&fp->buf[fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)], wbuff, wcnt); /* Fit partial sector */ + fp->flag |= FA__DIRTY; +#endif + } + + if (fp->fptr > fp->fsize) fp->fsize = fp->fptr; /* Update file size if needed */ + fp->flag |= FA__WRITTEN; /* Set file change flag */ + + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_OK); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Synchronize the File Object */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_sync ( + FIL *fp /* Pointer to the file object */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DWORD tim; + BYTE *dir; + + + res = validate(fp); /* Check validity of the object */ + if (res == FR_OK) { + if (fp->flag & FA__WRITTEN) { /* Has the file been written? */ +#if !_FS_TINY /* Write-back dirty buffer */ + if (fp->flag & FA__DIRTY) { + if (disk_write(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, fp->dsect, 1) != RES_OK) + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->flag &= ~FA__DIRTY; + } +#endif + /* Update the directory entry */ + res = move_window(fp->fs, fp->dir_sect); + if (res == FR_OK) { + dir = fp->dir_ptr; + dir[DIR_Attr] |= AM_ARC; /* Set archive bit */ + ST_DWORD(dir+DIR_FileSize, fp->fsize); /* Update file size */ + st_clust(dir, fp->sclust); /* Update start cluster */ + tim = get_fattime(); /* Update updated time */ + ST_DWORD(dir+DIR_WrtTime, tim); + ST_WORD(dir+DIR_LstAccDate, 0); + fp->flag &= ~FA__WRITTEN; + fp->fs->wflag = 1; + res = sync(fp->fs); + } + } + } + + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); +} + +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Close File */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_close ( + FIL *fp /* Pointer to the file object to be closed */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + + +#if _FS_READONLY + res = validate(fp); + { +#if _FS_REENTRANT + FATFS *fs = fp->fs; +#endif + if (res == FR_OK) fp->fs = 0; /* Discard file object */ + LEAVE_FF(fs, res); + } +#else + res = f_sync(fp); /* Flush cached data */ +#if _FS_LOCK + if (res == FR_OK) { /* Decrement open counter */ +#if _FS_REENTRANT + FATFS *fs = fp->fs;; + res = validate(fp); + if (res == FR_OK) { + res = dec_lock(fp->lockid); + unlock_fs(fs, FR_OK); + } +#else + res = dec_lock(fp->lockid); +#endif + } +#endif + if (res == FR_OK) fp->fs = 0; /* Discard file object */ + return res; +#endif +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Current Drive/Directory Handlings */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#if _FS_RPATH >= 1 + +FRESULT f_chdrive ( + BYTE drv /* Drive number */ +) +{ + if (drv >= _VOLUMES) return FR_INVALID_DRIVE; + + CurrVol = drv; + + return FR_OK; +} + + + +FRESULT f_chdir ( + const TCHAR *path /* Pointer to the directory path */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DIR dj; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 0); + if (res == FR_OK) { + INIT_BUF(dj); + res = follow_path(&dj, path); /* Follow the path */ + FREE_BUF(); + if (res == FR_OK) { /* Follow completed */ + if (!dj.dir) { + dj.fs->cdir = dj.sclust; /* Start directory itself */ + } else { + if (dj.dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR) /* Reached to the directory */ + dj.fs->cdir = ld_clust(dj.fs, dj.dir); + else + res = FR_NO_PATH; /* Reached but a file */ + } + } + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) res = FR_NO_PATH; + } + + LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + +#if _FS_RPATH >= 2 +FRESULT f_getcwd ( + TCHAR *path, /* Pointer to the directory path */ + UINT sz_path /* Size of path */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DIR dj; + UINT i, n; + DWORD ccl; + TCHAR *tp; + FILINFO fno; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + *path = 0; + res = chk_mounted((const TCHAR**)&path, &dj.fs, 0); /* Get current volume */ + if (res == FR_OK) { + INIT_BUF(dj); + i = sz_path; /* Bottom of buffer (dir stack base) */ + dj.sclust = dj.fs->cdir; /* Start to follow upper dir from current dir */ + while ((ccl = dj.sclust) != 0) { /* Repeat while current dir is a sub-dir */ + res = dir_sdi(&dj, 1); /* Get parent dir */ + if (res != FR_OK) break; + res = dir_read(&dj); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + dj.sclust = ld_clust(dj.fs, dj.dir); /* Goto parent dir */ + res = dir_sdi(&dj, 0); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + do { /* Find the entry links to the child dir */ + res = dir_read(&dj); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + if (ccl == ld_clust(dj.fs, dj.dir)) break; /* Found the entry */ + res = dir_next(&dj, 0); + } while (res == FR_OK); + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) res = FR_INT_ERR;/* It cannot be 'not found'. */ + if (res != FR_OK) break; +#if _USE_LFN + fno.lfname = path; + fno.lfsize = i; +#endif + get_fileinfo(&dj, &fno); /* Get the dir name and push it to the buffer */ + tp = fno.fname; + if (_USE_LFN && *path) tp = path; + for (n = 0; tp[n]; n++) ; + if (i < n + 3) { + res = FR_NOT_ENOUGH_CORE; break; + } + while (n) path[--i] = tp[--n]; + path[--i] = '/'; + } + tp = path; + if (res == FR_OK) { + *tp++ = '0' + CurrVol; /* Put drive number */ + *tp++ = ':'; + if (i == sz_path) { /* Root-dir */ + *tp++ = '/'; + } else { /* Sub-dir */ + do /* Add stacked path str */ + *tp++ = path[i++]; + while (i < sz_path); + } + } + *tp = 0; + FREE_BUF(); + } + + LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} +#endif /* _FS_RPATH >= 2 */ +#endif /* _FS_RPATH >= 1 */ + + + +#if _FS_MINIMIZE <= 2 +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Seek File R/W Pointer */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_lseek ( + FIL *fp, /* Pointer to the file object */ + DWORD ofs /* File pointer from top of file */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + + + res = validate(fp); /* Check validity of the object */ + if (res != FR_OK) LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); + if (fp->flag & FA__ERROR) /* Check abort flag */ + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + +#if _USE_FASTSEEK + if (fp->cltbl) { /* Fast seek */ + DWORD cl, pcl, ncl, tcl, dsc, tlen, ulen, *tbl; + + if (ofs == CREATE_LINKMAP) { /* Create CLMT */ + tbl = fp->cltbl; + tlen = *tbl++; ulen = 2; /* Given table size and required table size */ + cl = fp->sclust; /* Top of the chain */ + if (cl) { + do { + /* Get a fragment */ + tcl = cl; ncl = 0; ulen += 2; /* Top, length and used items */ + do { + pcl = cl; ncl++; + cl = get_fat(fp->fs, cl); + if (cl <= 1) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + if (cl == 0xFFFFFFFF) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + } while (cl == pcl + 1); + if (ulen <= tlen) { /* Store the length and top of the fragment */ + *tbl++ = ncl; *tbl++ = tcl; + } + } while (cl < fp->fs->n_fatent); /* Repeat until end of chain */ + } + *fp->cltbl = ulen; /* Number of items used */ + if (ulen <= tlen) + *tbl = 0; /* Terminate table */ + else + res = FR_NOT_ENOUGH_CORE; /* Given table size is smaller than required */ + + } else { /* Fast seek */ + if (ofs > fp->fsize) /* Clip offset at the file size */ + ofs = fp->fsize; + fp->fptr = ofs; /* Set file pointer */ + if (ofs) { + fp->clust = clmt_clust(fp, ofs - 1); + dsc = clust2sect(fp->fs, fp->clust); + if (!dsc) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + dsc += (ofs - 1) / SS(fp->fs) & (fp->fs->csize - 1); + if (fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs) && dsc != fp->dsect) { /* Refill sector cache if needed */ +#if !_FS_TINY +#if !_FS_READONLY + if (fp->flag & FA__DIRTY) { /* Write-back dirty sector cache */ + if (disk_write(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, fp->dsect, 1) != RES_OK) + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->flag &= ~FA__DIRTY; + } +#endif + if (disk_read(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, dsc, 1) != RES_OK) /* Load current sector */ + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +#endif + fp->dsect = dsc; + } + } + } + } else +#endif + + /* Normal Seek */ + { + DWORD clst, bcs, nsect, ifptr; + + if (ofs > fp->fsize /* In read-only mode, clip offset with the file size */ +#if !_FS_READONLY + && !(fp->flag & FA_WRITE) +#endif + ) ofs = fp->fsize; + + ifptr = fp->fptr; + fp->fptr = nsect = 0; + if (ofs) { + bcs = (DWORD)fp->fs->csize * SS(fp->fs); /* Cluster size (byte) */ + if (ifptr > 0 && + (ofs - 1) / bcs >= (ifptr - 1) / bcs) { /* When seek to same or following cluster, */ + fp->fptr = (ifptr - 1) & ~(bcs - 1); /* start from the current cluster */ + ofs -= fp->fptr; + clst = fp->clust; + } else { /* When seek to back cluster, */ + clst = fp->sclust; /* start from the first cluster */ +#if !_FS_READONLY + if (clst == 0) { /* If no cluster chain, create a new chain */ + clst = create_chain(fp->fs, 0); + if (clst == 1) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->sclust = clst; + } +#endif + fp->clust = clst; + } + if (clst != 0) { + while (ofs > bcs) { /* Cluster following loop */ +#if !_FS_READONLY + if (fp->flag & FA_WRITE) { /* Check if in write mode or not */ + clst = create_chain(fp->fs, clst); /* Force stretch if in write mode */ + if (clst == 0) { /* When disk gets full, clip file size */ + ofs = bcs; break; + } + } else +#endif + clst = get_fat(fp->fs, clst); /* Follow cluster chain if not in write mode */ + if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + if (clst <= 1 || clst >= fp->fs->n_fatent) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + fp->clust = clst; + fp->fptr += bcs; + ofs -= bcs; + } + fp->fptr += ofs; + if (ofs % SS(fp->fs)) { + nsect = clust2sect(fp->fs, clst); /* Current sector */ + if (!nsect) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + nsect += ofs / SS(fp->fs); + } + } + } + if (fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs) && nsect != fp->dsect) { /* Fill sector cache if needed */ +#if !_FS_TINY +#if !_FS_READONLY + if (fp->flag & FA__DIRTY) { /* Write-back dirty sector cache */ + if (disk_write(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, fp->dsect, 1) != RES_OK) + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->flag &= ~FA__DIRTY; + } +#endif + if (disk_read(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, nsect, 1) != RES_OK) /* Fill sector cache */ + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +#endif + fp->dsect = nsect; + } +#if !_FS_READONLY + if (fp->fptr > fp->fsize) { /* Set file change flag if the file size is extended */ + fp->fsize = fp->fptr; + fp->flag |= FA__WRITTEN; + } +#endif + } + + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); +} + + + +#if _FS_MINIMIZE <= 1 +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Create a Directory Object */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_opendir ( + DIR *dj, /* Pointer to directory object to create */ + const TCHAR *path /* Pointer to the directory path */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + FATFS *fs; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + if (!dj) return FR_INVALID_OBJECT; + + res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj->fs, 0); + fs = dj->fs; + if (res == FR_OK) { + INIT_BUF(*dj); + res = follow_path(dj, path); /* Follow the path to the directory */ + FREE_BUF(); + if (res == FR_OK) { /* Follow completed */ + if (dj->dir) { /* It is not the root dir */ + if (dj->dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR) { /* The object is a directory */ + dj->sclust = ld_clust(fs, dj->dir); + } else { /* The object is not a directory */ + res = FR_NO_PATH; + } + } + if (res == FR_OK) { + dj->id = fs->id; + res = dir_sdi(dj, 0); /* Rewind dir */ + } + } + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) res = FR_NO_PATH; + if (res != FR_OK) dj->fs = 0; /* Invalidate the dir object if function failed */ + } else { + dj->fs = 0; + } + + LEAVE_FF(fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Read Directory Entry in Sequence */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_readdir ( + DIR *dj, /* Pointer to the open directory object */ + FILINFO *fno /* Pointer to file information to return */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + res = validate(dj); /* Check validity of the object */ + if (res == FR_OK) { + if (!fno) { + res = dir_sdi(dj, 0); /* Rewind the directory object */ + } else { + INIT_BUF(*dj); + res = dir_read(dj); /* Read an directory item */ + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) { /* Reached end of dir */ + dj->sect = 0; + res = FR_OK; + } + if (res == FR_OK) { /* A valid entry is found */ + get_fileinfo(dj, fno); /* Get the object information */ + res = dir_next(dj, 0); /* Increment index for next */ + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) { + dj->sect = 0; + res = FR_OK; + } + } + FREE_BUF(); + } + } + + LEAVE_FF(dj->fs, res); +} + + + +#if _FS_MINIMIZE == 0 +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Get File Status */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_stat ( + const TCHAR *path, /* Pointer to the file path */ + FILINFO *fno /* Pointer to file information to return */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DIR dj; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 0); + if (res == FR_OK) { + INIT_BUF(dj); + res = follow_path(&dj, path); /* Follow the file path */ + if (res == FR_OK) { /* Follow completed */ + if (dj.dir) /* Found an object */ + get_fileinfo(&dj, fno); + else /* It is root dir */ + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; + } + FREE_BUF(); + } + + LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + + +#if !_FS_READONLY +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Get Number of Free Clusters */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_getfree ( + const TCHAR *path, /* Pointer to the logical drive number (root dir) */ + DWORD *nclst, /* Pointer to the variable to return number of free clusters */ + FATFS **fatfs /* Pointer to pointer to corresponding file system object to return */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + FATFS *fs; + DWORD n, clst, sect, stat; + UINT i; + BYTE fat, *p; + + + /* Get drive number */ + res = chk_mounted(&path, fatfs, 0); + fs = *fatfs; + if (res == FR_OK) { + /* If free_clust is valid, return it without full cluster scan */ + if (fs->free_clust <= fs->n_fatent - 2) { + *nclst = fs->free_clust; + } else { + /* Get number of free clusters */ + fat = fs->fs_type; + n = 0; + if (fat == FS_FAT12) { + clst = 2; + do { + stat = get_fat(fs, clst); + if (stat == 0xFFFFFFFF) { res = FR_DISK_ERR; break; } + if (stat == 1) { res = FR_INT_ERR; break; } + if (stat == 0) n++; + } while (++clst < fs->n_fatent); + } else { + clst = fs->n_fatent; + sect = fs->fatbase; + i = 0; p = 0; + do { + if (!i) { + res = move_window(fs, sect++); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + p = fs->win; + i = SS(fs); + } + if (fat == FS_FAT16) { + if (LD_WORD(p) == 0) n++; + p += 2; i -= 2; + } else { + if ((LD_DWORD(p) & 0x0FFFFFFF) == 0) n++; + p += 4; i -= 4; + } + } while (--clst); + } + fs->free_clust = n; + if (fat == FS_FAT32) fs->fsi_flag = 1; + *nclst = n; + } + } + LEAVE_FF(fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Truncate File */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_truncate ( + FIL *fp /* Pointer to the file object */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DWORD ncl; + + + if (!fp) return FR_INVALID_OBJECT; + + res = validate(fp); /* Check validity of the object */ + if (res == FR_OK) { + if (fp->flag & FA__ERROR) { /* Check abort flag */ + res = FR_INT_ERR; + } else { + if (!(fp->flag & FA_WRITE)) /* Check access mode */ + res = FR_DENIED; + } + } + if (res == FR_OK) { + if (fp->fsize > fp->fptr) { + fp->fsize = fp->fptr; /* Set file size to current R/W point */ + fp->flag |= FA__WRITTEN; + if (fp->fptr == 0) { /* When set file size to zero, remove entire cluster chain */ + res = remove_chain(fp->fs, fp->sclust); + fp->sclust = 0; + } else { /* When truncate a part of the file, remove remaining clusters */ + ncl = get_fat(fp->fs, fp->clust); + res = FR_OK; + if (ncl == 0xFFFFFFFF) res = FR_DISK_ERR; + if (ncl == 1) res = FR_INT_ERR; + if (res == FR_OK && ncl < fp->fs->n_fatent) { + res = put_fat(fp->fs, fp->clust, 0x0FFFFFFF); + if (res == FR_OK) res = remove_chain(fp->fs, ncl); + } + } + } + if (res != FR_OK) fp->flag |= FA__ERROR; + } + + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Delete a File or Directory */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_unlink ( + const TCHAR *path /* Pointer to the file or directory path */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DIR dj, sdj; + BYTE *dir; + DWORD dclst; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 1); + if (res == FR_OK) { + INIT_BUF(dj); + res = follow_path(&dj, path); /* Follow the file path */ + if (_FS_RPATH && res == FR_OK && (dj.fn[NS] & NS_DOT)) + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; /* Cannot remove dot entry */ +#if _FS_LOCK + if (res == FR_OK) res = chk_lock(&dj, 2); /* Cannot remove open file */ +#endif + if (res == FR_OK) { /* The object is accessible */ + dir = dj.dir; + if (!dir) { + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; /* Cannot remove the start directory */ + } else { + if (dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_RDO) + res = FR_DENIED; /* Cannot remove R/O object */ + } + dclst = ld_clust(dj.fs, dir); + if (res == FR_OK && (dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR)) { /* Is it a sub-dir? */ + if (dclst < 2) { + res = FR_INT_ERR; + } else { + mem_cpy(&sdj, &dj, sizeof (DIR)); /* Check if the sub-dir is empty or not */ + sdj.sclust = dclst; + res = dir_sdi(&sdj, 2); /* Exclude dot entries */ + if (res == FR_OK) { + res = dir_read(&sdj); + if (res == FR_OK /* Not empty dir */ +#if _FS_RPATH + || dclst == dj.fs->cdir /* Current dir */ +#endif + ) res = FR_DENIED; + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) res = FR_OK; /* Empty */ + } + } + } + if (res == FR_OK) { + res = dir_remove(&dj); /* Remove the directory entry */ + if (res == FR_OK) { + if (dclst) /* Remove the cluster chain if exist */ + res = remove_chain(dj.fs, dclst); + if (res == FR_OK) res = sync(dj.fs); + } + } + } + FREE_BUF(); + } + LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Create a Directory */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_mkdir ( + const TCHAR *path /* Pointer to the directory path */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DIR dj; + BYTE *dir, n; + DWORD dsc, dcl, pcl, tim = get_fattime(); + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 1); + if (res == FR_OK) { + INIT_BUF(dj); + res = follow_path(&dj, path); /* Follow the file path */ + if (res == FR_OK) res = FR_EXIST; /* Any object with same name is already existing */ + if (_FS_RPATH && res == FR_NO_FILE && (dj.fn[NS] & NS_DOT)) + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) { /* Can create a new directory */ + dcl = create_chain(dj.fs, 0); /* Allocate a cluster for the new directory table */ + res = FR_OK; + if (dcl == 0) res = FR_DENIED; /* No space to allocate a new cluster */ + if (dcl == 1) res = FR_INT_ERR; + if (dcl == 0xFFFFFFFF) res = FR_DISK_ERR; + if (res == FR_OK) /* Flush FAT */ + res = move_window(dj.fs, 0); + if (res == FR_OK) { /* Initialize the new directory table */ + dsc = clust2sect(dj.fs, dcl); + dir = dj.fs->win; + mem_set(dir, 0, SS(dj.fs)); + mem_set(dir+DIR_Name, ' ', 8+3); /* Create "." entry */ + dir[DIR_Name] = '.'; + dir[DIR_Attr] = AM_DIR; + ST_DWORD(dir+DIR_WrtTime, tim); + st_clust(dir, dcl); + mem_cpy(dir+SZ_DIR, dir, SZ_DIR); /* Create ".." entry */ + dir[33] = '.'; pcl = dj.sclust; + if (dj.fs->fs_type == FS_FAT32 && pcl == dj.fs->dirbase) + pcl = 0; + st_clust(dir+SZ_DIR, pcl); + for (n = dj.fs->csize; n; n--) { /* Write dot entries and clear following sectors */ + dj.fs->winsect = dsc++; + dj.fs->wflag = 1; + res = move_window(dj.fs, 0); + if (res != FR_OK) break; + mem_set(dir, 0, SS(dj.fs)); + } + } + if (res == FR_OK) res = dir_register(&dj); /* Register the object to the directory */ + if (res != FR_OK) { + remove_chain(dj.fs, dcl); /* Could not register, remove cluster chain */ + } else { + dir = dj.dir; + dir[DIR_Attr] = AM_DIR; /* Attribute */ + ST_DWORD(dir+DIR_WrtTime, tim); /* Created time */ + st_clust(dir, dcl); /* Table start cluster */ + dj.fs->wflag = 1; + res = sync(dj.fs); + } + } + FREE_BUF(); + } + + LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Change Attribute */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_chmod ( + const TCHAR *path, /* Pointer to the file path */ + BYTE value, /* Attribute bits */ + BYTE mask /* Attribute mask to change */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DIR dj; + BYTE *dir; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 1); + if (res == FR_OK) { + INIT_BUF(dj); + res = follow_path(&dj, path); /* Follow the file path */ + FREE_BUF(); + if (_FS_RPATH && res == FR_OK && (dj.fn[NS] & NS_DOT)) + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; + if (res == FR_OK) { + dir = dj.dir; + if (!dir) { /* Is it a root directory? */ + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; + } else { /* File or sub directory */ + mask &= AM_RDO|AM_HID|AM_SYS|AM_ARC; /* Valid attribute mask */ + dir[DIR_Attr] = (value & mask) | (dir[DIR_Attr] & (BYTE)~mask); /* Apply attribute change */ + dj.fs->wflag = 1; + res = sync(dj.fs); + } + } + } + + LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Change Timestamp */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_utime ( + const TCHAR *path, /* Pointer to the file/directory name */ + const FILINFO *fno /* Pointer to the time stamp to be set */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DIR dj; + BYTE *dir; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 1); + if (res == FR_OK) { + INIT_BUF(dj); + res = follow_path(&dj, path); /* Follow the file path */ + FREE_BUF(); + if (_FS_RPATH && res == FR_OK && (dj.fn[NS] & NS_DOT)) + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; + if (res == FR_OK) { + dir = dj.dir; + if (!dir) { /* Root directory */ + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; + } else { /* File or sub-directory */ + ST_WORD(dir+DIR_WrtTime, fno->ftime); + ST_WORD(dir+DIR_WrtDate, fno->fdate); + dj.fs->wflag = 1; + res = sync(dj.fs); + } + } + } + + LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Rename File/Directory */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_rename ( + const TCHAR *path_old, /* Pointer to the old name */ + const TCHAR *path_new /* Pointer to the new name */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DIR djo, djn; + BYTE buf[21], *dir; + DWORD dw; + DEF_NAMEBUF; + + + res = chk_mounted(&path_old, &djo.fs, 1); + if (res == FR_OK) { + djn.fs = djo.fs; + INIT_BUF(djo); + res = follow_path(&djo, path_old); /* Check old object */ + if (_FS_RPATH && res == FR_OK && (djo.fn[NS] & NS_DOT)) + res = FR_INVALID_NAME; +#if _FS_LOCK + if (res == FR_OK) res = chk_lock(&djo, 2); +#endif + if (res == FR_OK) { /* Old object is found */ + if (!djo.dir) { /* Is root dir? */ + res = FR_NO_FILE; + } else { + mem_cpy(buf, djo.dir+DIR_Attr, 21); /* Save the object information except for name */ + mem_cpy(&djn, &djo, sizeof (DIR)); /* Check new object */ + res = follow_path(&djn, path_new); + if (res == FR_OK) res = FR_EXIST; /* The new object name is already existing */ + if (res == FR_NO_FILE) { /* Is it a valid path and no name collision? */ +/* Start critical section that an interruption or error can cause cross-link */ + res = dir_register(&djn); /* Register the new entry */ + if (res == FR_OK) { + dir = djn.dir; /* Copy object information except for name */ + mem_cpy(dir+13, buf+2, 19); + dir[DIR_Attr] = buf[0] | AM_ARC; + djo.fs->wflag = 1; + if (djo.sclust != djn.sclust && (dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR)) { /* Update .. entry in the directory if needed */ + dw = clust2sect(djo.fs, ld_clust(djo.fs, dir)); + if (!dw) { + res = FR_INT_ERR; + } else { + res = move_window(djo.fs, dw); + dir = djo.fs->win+SZ_DIR; /* .. entry */ + if (res == FR_OK && dir[1] == '.') { + dw = (djo.fs->fs_type == FS_FAT32 && djn.sclust == djo.fs->dirbase) ? 0 : djn.sclust; + st_clust(dir, dw); + djo.fs->wflag = 1; + } + } + } + if (res == FR_OK) { + res = dir_remove(&djo); /* Remove old entry */ + if (res == FR_OK) + res = sync(djo.fs); + } + } +/* End critical section */ + } + } + } + FREE_BUF(); + } + LEAVE_FF(djo.fs, res); +} + +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ +#endif /* _FS_MINIMIZE == 0 */ +#endif /* _FS_MINIMIZE <= 1 */ +#endif /* _FS_MINIMIZE <= 2 */ + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Forward data to the stream directly (available on only tiny cfg) */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _USE_FORWARD && _FS_TINY + +FRESULT f_forward ( + FIL *fp, /* Pointer to the file object */ + UINT (*func)(const BYTE*,UINT), /* Pointer to the streaming function */ + UINT btr, /* Number of bytes to forward */ + UINT *bf /* Pointer to number of bytes forwarded */ +) +{ + FRESULT res; + DWORD remain, clst, sect; + UINT rcnt; + BYTE csect; + + + *bf = 0; /* Clear transfer byte counter */ + + if (!fp) return FR_INVALID_OBJECT; + + res = validate(fp); /* Check validity of the object */ + if (res != FR_OK) LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); + if (fp->flag & FA__ERROR) /* Check error flag */ + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + if (!(fp->flag & FA_READ)) /* Check access mode */ + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_DENIED); + + remain = fp->fsize - fp->fptr; + if (btr > remain) btr = (UINT)remain; /* Truncate btr by remaining bytes */ + + for ( ; btr && (*func)(0, 0); /* Repeat until all data transferred or stream becomes busy */ + fp->fptr += rcnt, *bf += rcnt, btr -= rcnt) { + csect = (BYTE)(fp->fptr / SS(fp->fs) & (fp->fs->csize - 1)); /* Sector offset in the cluster */ + if ((fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)) == 0) { /* On the sector boundary? */ + if (!csect) { /* On the cluster boundary? */ + clst = (fp->fptr == 0) ? /* On the top of the file? */ + fp->sclust : get_fat(fp->fs, fp->clust); + if (clst <= 1) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->clust = clst; /* Update current cluster */ + } + } + sect = clust2sect(fp->fs, fp->clust); /* Get current data sector */ + if (!sect) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + sect += csect; + if (move_window(fp->fs, sect)) /* Move sector window */ + ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); + fp->dsect = sect; + rcnt = SS(fp->fs) - (WORD)(fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)); /* Forward data from sector window */ + if (rcnt > btr) rcnt = btr; + rcnt = (*func)(&fp->fs->win[(WORD)fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)], rcnt); + if (!rcnt) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + } + + LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_OK); +} +#endif /* _USE_FORWARD */ + + + +#if _USE_MKFS && !_FS_READONLY +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Create File System on the Drive */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#define N_ROOTDIR 512 /* Number of root dir entries for FAT12/16 */ +#define N_FATS 1 /* Number of FAT copies (1 or 2) */ + + +FRESULT f_mkfs ( + BYTE drv, /* Logical drive number */ + BYTE sfd, /* Partitioning rule 0:FDISK, 1:SFD */ + UINT au /* Allocation unit size [bytes] */ +) +{ + static const WORD vst[] = { 1024, 512, 256, 128, 64, 32, 16, 8, 4, 2, 0}; + static const WORD cst[] = {32768, 16384, 8192, 4096, 2048, 16384, 8192, 4096, 2048, 1024, 512}; + BYTE fmt, md, sys, *tbl, pdrv, part; + DWORD n_clst, vs, n, wsect; + UINT i; + DWORD b_vol, b_fat, b_dir, b_data; /* LBA */ + DWORD n_vol, n_rsv, n_fat, n_dir; /* Size */ + FATFS *fs; + DSTATUS stat; + + + /* Check mounted drive and clear work area */ + if (drv >= _VOLUMES) return FR_INVALID_DRIVE; + if (sfd > 1) return FR_INVALID_PARAMETER; + if (au & (au - 1)) return FR_INVALID_PARAMETER; + fs = FatFs[drv]; + if (!fs) return FR_NOT_ENABLED; + fs->fs_type = 0; + pdrv = LD2PD(drv); /* Physical drive */ + part = LD2PT(drv); /* Partition (0:auto detect, 1-4:get from partition table)*/ + + /* Get disk statics */ + stat = disk_initialize(pdrv); + if (stat & STA_NOINIT) return FR_NOT_READY; + if (stat & STA_PROTECT) return FR_WRITE_PROTECTED; +#if _MAX_SS != 512 /* Get disk sector size */ + if (disk_ioctl(pdrv, GET_SECTOR_SIZE, &SS(fs)) != RES_OK || SS(fs) > _MAX_SS) + return FR_DISK_ERR; +#endif + if (_MULTI_PARTITION && part) { + /* Get partition information from partition table in the MBR */ + if (disk_read(pdrv, fs->win, 0, 1) != RES_OK) return FR_DISK_ERR; + if (LD_WORD(fs->win+BS_55AA) != 0xAA55) return FR_MKFS_ABORTED; + tbl = &fs->win[MBR_Table + (part - 1) * SZ_PTE]; + if (!tbl[4]) return FR_MKFS_ABORTED; /* No partition? */ + b_vol = LD_DWORD(tbl+8); /* Volume start sector */ + n_vol = LD_DWORD(tbl+12); /* Volume size */ + } else { + /* Create a partition in this function */ + if (disk_ioctl(pdrv, GET_SECTOR_COUNT, &n_vol) != RES_OK || n_vol < 128) + return FR_DISK_ERR; + b_vol = (sfd) ? 0 : 63; /* Volume start sector */ + n_vol -= b_vol; /* Volume size */ + } + + if (!au) { /* AU auto selection */ + vs = n_vol / (2000 / (SS(fs) / 512)); + for (i = 0; vs < vst[i]; i++) ; + au = cst[i]; + } + au /= SS(fs); /* Number of sectors per cluster */ + if (au == 0) au = 1; + if (au > 128) au = 128; + + /* Pre-compute number of clusters and FAT sub-type */ + n_clst = n_vol / au; + fmt = FS_FAT12; + if (n_clst >= MIN_FAT16) fmt = FS_FAT16; + if (n_clst >= MIN_FAT32) fmt = FS_FAT32; + + /* Determine offset and size of FAT structure */ + if (fmt == FS_FAT32) { + n_fat = ((n_clst * 4) + 8 + SS(fs) - 1) / SS(fs); + n_rsv = 32; + n_dir = 0; + } else { + n_fat = (fmt == FS_FAT12) ? (n_clst * 3 + 1) / 2 + 3 : (n_clst * 2) + 4; + n_fat = (n_fat + SS(fs) - 1) / SS(fs); + n_rsv = 1; + n_dir = (DWORD)N_ROOTDIR * SZ_DIR / SS(fs); + } + b_fat = b_vol + n_rsv; /* FAT area start sector */ + b_dir = b_fat + n_fat * N_FATS; /* Directory area start sector */ + b_data = b_dir + n_dir; /* Data area start sector */ + if (n_vol < b_data + au - b_vol) return FR_MKFS_ABORTED; /* Too small volume */ + + /* Align data start sector to erase block boundary (for flash memory media) */ + if (disk_ioctl(pdrv, GET_BLOCK_SIZE, &n) != RES_OK || !n || n > 32768) n = 1; + n = (b_data + n - 1) & ~(n - 1); /* Next nearest erase block from current data start */ + n = (n - b_data) / N_FATS; + if (fmt == FS_FAT32) { /* FAT32: Move FAT offset */ + n_rsv += n; + b_fat += n; + } else { /* FAT12/16: Expand FAT size */ + n_fat += n; + } + + /* Determine number of clusters and final check of validity of the FAT sub-type */ + n_clst = (n_vol - n_rsv - n_fat * N_FATS - n_dir) / au; + if ( (fmt == FS_FAT16 && n_clst < MIN_FAT16) + || (fmt == FS_FAT32 && n_clst < MIN_FAT32)) + return FR_MKFS_ABORTED; + + switch (fmt) { /* Determine system ID for partition table */ + case FS_FAT12: sys = 0x01; break; + case FS_FAT16: sys = (n_vol < 0x10000) ? 0x04 : 0x06; break; + default: sys = 0x0C; + } + + if (_MULTI_PARTITION && part) { + /* Update system ID in the partition table */ + tbl = &fs->win[MBR_Table + (part - 1) * SZ_PTE]; + tbl[4] = sys; + if (disk_write(pdrv, fs->win, 0, 1) != RES_OK) return FR_DISK_ERR; + md = 0xF8; + } else { + if (sfd) { /* No partition table (SFD) */ + md = 0xF0; + } else { /* Create partition table (FDISK) */ + mem_set(fs->win, 0, SS(fs)); + tbl = fs->win+MBR_Table; /* Create partition table for single partition in the drive */ + tbl[1] = 1; /* Partition start head */ + tbl[2] = 1; /* Partition start sector */ + tbl[3] = 0; /* Partition start cylinder */ + tbl[4] = sys; /* System type */ + tbl[5] = 254; /* Partition end head */ + n = (b_vol + n_vol) / 63 / 255; + tbl[6] = (BYTE)((n >> 2) | 63); /* Partition end sector */ + tbl[7] = (BYTE)n; /* End cylinder */ + ST_DWORD(tbl+8, 63); /* Partition start in LBA */ + ST_DWORD(tbl+12, n_vol); /* Partition size in LBA */ + ST_WORD(fs->win+BS_55AA, 0xAA55); /* MBR signature */ + if (disk_write(pdrv, fs->win, 0, 1) != RES_OK) /* Write it to the MBR sector */ + return FR_DISK_ERR; + md = 0xF8; + } + } + + /* Create BPB in the VBR */ + tbl = fs->win; /* Clear sector */ + mem_set(tbl, 0, SS(fs)); + mem_cpy(tbl, "\xEB\xFE\x90" "MSDOS5.0", 11);/* Boot jump code, OEM name */ + i = SS(fs); /* Sector size */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_BytsPerSec, i); + tbl[BPB_SecPerClus] = (BYTE)au; /* Sectors per cluster */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_RsvdSecCnt, n_rsv); /* Reserved sectors */ + tbl[BPB_NumFATs] = N_FATS; /* Number of FATs */ + i = (fmt == FS_FAT32) ? 0 : N_ROOTDIR; /* Number of rootdir entries */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_RootEntCnt, i); + if (n_vol < 0x10000) { /* Number of total sectors */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_TotSec16, n_vol); + } else { + ST_DWORD(tbl+BPB_TotSec32, n_vol); + } + tbl[BPB_Media] = md; /* Media descriptor */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_SecPerTrk, 63); /* Number of sectors per track */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_NumHeads, 255); /* Number of heads */ + ST_DWORD(tbl+BPB_HiddSec, b_vol); /* Hidden sectors */ + n = get_fattime(); /* Use current time as VSN */ + if (fmt == FS_FAT32) { + ST_DWORD(tbl+BS_VolID32, n); /* VSN */ + ST_DWORD(tbl+BPB_FATSz32, n_fat); /* Number of sectors per FAT */ + ST_DWORD(tbl+BPB_RootClus, 2); /* Root directory start cluster (2) */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_FSInfo, 1); /* FSInfo record offset (VBR+1) */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_BkBootSec, 6); /* Backup boot record offset (VBR+6) */ + tbl[BS_DrvNum32] = 0x80; /* Drive number */ + tbl[BS_BootSig32] = 0x29; /* Extended boot signature */ + mem_cpy(tbl+BS_VolLab32, "NO NAME " "FAT32 ", 19); /* Volume label, FAT signature */ + } else { + ST_DWORD(tbl+BS_VolID, n); /* VSN */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_FATSz16, n_fat); /* Number of sectors per FAT */ + tbl[BS_DrvNum] = 0x80; /* Drive number */ + tbl[BS_BootSig] = 0x29; /* Extended boot signature */ + mem_cpy(tbl+BS_VolLab, "NO NAME " "FAT ", 19); /* Volume label, FAT signature */ + } + ST_WORD(tbl+BS_55AA, 0xAA55); /* Signature (Offset is fixed here regardless of sector size) */ + if (disk_write(pdrv, tbl, b_vol, 1) != RES_OK) /* Write it to the VBR sector */ + return FR_DISK_ERR; + if (fmt == FS_FAT32) /* Write backup VBR if needed (VBR+6) */ + disk_write(pdrv, tbl, b_vol + 6, 1); + + /* Initialize FAT area */ + wsect = b_fat; + for (i = 0; i < N_FATS; i++) { /* Initialize each FAT copy */ + mem_set(tbl, 0, SS(fs)); /* 1st sector of the FAT */ + n = md; /* Media descriptor byte */ + if (fmt != FS_FAT32) { + n |= (fmt == FS_FAT12) ? 0x00FFFF00 : 0xFFFFFF00; + ST_DWORD(tbl+0, n); /* Reserve cluster #0-1 (FAT12/16) */ + } else { + n |= 0xFFFFFF00; + ST_DWORD(tbl+0, n); /* Reserve cluster #0-1 (FAT32) */ + ST_DWORD(tbl+4, 0xFFFFFFFF); + ST_DWORD(tbl+8, 0x0FFFFFFF); /* Reserve cluster #2 for root dir */ + } + if (disk_write(pdrv, tbl, wsect++, 1) != RES_OK) + return FR_DISK_ERR; + mem_set(tbl, 0, SS(fs)); /* Fill following FAT entries with zero */ + for (n = 1; n < n_fat; n++) { /* This loop may take a time on FAT32 volume due to many single sector writes */ + if (disk_write(pdrv, tbl, wsect++, 1) != RES_OK) + return FR_DISK_ERR; + } + } + + /* Initialize root directory */ + i = (fmt == FS_FAT32) ? au : n_dir; + do { + if (disk_write(pdrv, tbl, wsect++, 1) != RES_OK) + return FR_DISK_ERR; + } while (--i); + +#if _USE_ERASE /* Erase data area if needed */ + { + DWORD eb[2]; + + eb[0] = wsect; eb[1] = wsect + (n_clst - ((fmt == FS_FAT32) ? 1 : 0)) * au - 1; + disk_ioctl(pdrv, CTRL_ERASE_SECTOR, eb); + } +#endif + + /* Create FSInfo if needed */ + if (fmt == FS_FAT32) { + ST_DWORD(tbl+FSI_LeadSig, 0x41615252); + ST_DWORD(tbl+FSI_StrucSig, 0x61417272); + ST_DWORD(tbl+FSI_Free_Count, n_clst - 1); /* Number of free clusters */ + ST_DWORD(tbl+FSI_Nxt_Free, 2); /* Last allocated cluster# */ + ST_WORD(tbl+BS_55AA, 0xAA55); + disk_write(pdrv, tbl, b_vol + 1, 1); /* Write original (VBR+1) */ + disk_write(pdrv, tbl, b_vol + 7, 1); /* Write backup (VBR+7) */ + } + + return (disk_ioctl(pdrv, CTRL_SYNC, 0) == RES_OK) ? FR_OK : FR_DISK_ERR; +} + + +#if _MULTI_PARTITION == 2 +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Divide Physical Drive */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_fdisk ( + BYTE pdrv, /* Physical drive number */ + const DWORD szt[], /* Pointer to the size table for each partitions */ + void* work /* Pointer to the working buffer */ +) +{ + UINT i, n, sz_cyl, tot_cyl, b_cyl, e_cyl, p_cyl; + BYTE s_hd, e_hd, *p, *buf = (BYTE*)work; + DSTATUS stat; + DWORD sz_disk, sz_part, s_part; + + + stat = disk_initialize(pdrv); + if (stat & STA_NOINIT) return FR_NOT_READY; + if (stat & STA_PROTECT) return FR_WRITE_PROTECTED; + if (disk_ioctl(pdrv, GET_SECTOR_COUNT, &sz_disk)) return FR_DISK_ERR; + + /* Determine CHS in the table regardless of the drive geometry */ + for (n = 16; n < 256 && sz_disk / n / 63 > 1024; n *= 2) ; + if (n == 256) n--; + e_hd = n - 1; + sz_cyl = 63 * n; + tot_cyl = sz_disk / sz_cyl; + + /* Create partition table */ + mem_set(buf, 0, _MAX_SS); + p = buf + MBR_Table; b_cyl = 0; + for (i = 0; i < 4; i++, p += SZ_PTE) { + p_cyl = (szt[i] <= 100) ? (DWORD)tot_cyl * szt[i] / 100 : szt[i] / sz_cyl; + if (!p_cyl) continue; + s_part = (DWORD)sz_cyl * b_cyl; + sz_part = (DWORD)sz_cyl * p_cyl; + if (i == 0) { /* Exclude first track of cylinder 0 */ + s_hd = 1; + s_part += 63; sz_part -= 63; + } else { + s_hd = 0; + } + e_cyl = b_cyl + p_cyl - 1; + if (e_cyl >= tot_cyl) return FR_INVALID_PARAMETER; + + /* Set partition table */ + p[1] = s_hd; /* Start head */ + p[2] = (BYTE)((b_cyl >> 2) + 1); /* Start sector */ + p[3] = (BYTE)b_cyl; /* Start cylinder */ + p[4] = 0x06; /* System type (temporary setting) */ + p[5] = e_hd; /* End head */ + p[6] = (BYTE)((e_cyl >> 2) + 63); /* End sector */ + p[7] = (BYTE)e_cyl; /* End cylinder */ + ST_DWORD(p + 8, s_part); /* Start sector in LBA */ + ST_DWORD(p + 12, sz_part); /* Partition size */ + + /* Next partition */ + b_cyl += p_cyl; + } + ST_WORD(p, 0xAA55); + + /* Write it to the MBR */ + return (disk_write(pdrv, buf, 0, 1) || disk_ioctl(pdrv, CTRL_SYNC, 0)) ? FR_DISK_ERR : FR_OK; +} + + +#endif /* _MULTI_PARTITION == 2 */ +#endif /* _USE_MKFS && !_FS_READONLY */ + + + + +#if _USE_STRFUNC +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Get a string from the file */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +TCHAR* f_gets ( + TCHAR* buff, /* Pointer to the string buffer to read */ + int len, /* Size of string buffer (characters) */ + FIL* fil /* Pointer to the file object */ +) +{ + int n = 0; + TCHAR c, *p = buff; + BYTE s[2]; + UINT rc; + + + while (n < len - 1) { /* Read bytes until buffer gets filled */ + f_read(fil, s, 1, &rc); + if (rc != 1) break; /* Break on EOF or error */ + c = s[0]; +#if _LFN_UNICODE /* Read a character in UTF-8 encoding */ + if (c >= 0x80) { + if (c < 0xC0) continue; /* Skip stray trailer */ + if (c < 0xE0) { /* Two-byte sequence */ + f_read(fil, s, 1, &rc); + if (rc != 1) break; + c = ((c & 0x1F) << 6) | (s[0] & 0x3F); + if (c < 0x80) c = '?'; + } else { + if (c < 0xF0) { /* Three-byte sequence */ + f_read(fil, s, 2, &rc); + if (rc != 2) break; + c = (c << 12) | ((s[0] & 0x3F) << 6) | (s[1] & 0x3F); + if (c < 0x800) c = '?'; + } else { /* Reject four-byte sequence */ + c = '?'; + } + } + } +#endif +#if _USE_STRFUNC >= 2 + if (c == '\r') continue; /* Strip '\r' */ +#endif + *p++ = c; + n++; + if (c == '\n') break; /* Break on EOL */ + } + *p = 0; + return n ? buff : 0; /* When no data read (eof or error), return with error. */ +} + + + +#if !_FS_READONLY +#include <stdarg.h> +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Put a character to the file */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +int f_putc ( + TCHAR c, /* A character to be output */ + FIL* fil /* Pointer to the file object */ +) +{ + UINT bw, btw; + BYTE s[3]; + + +#if _USE_STRFUNC >= 2 + if (c == '\n') f_putc ('\r', fil); /* LF -> CRLF conversion */ +#endif + +#if _LFN_UNICODE /* Write the character in UTF-8 encoding */ + if (c < 0x80) { /* 7-bit */ + s[0] = (BYTE)c; + btw = 1; + } else { + if (c < 0x800) { /* 11-bit */ + s[0] = (BYTE)(0xC0 | (c >> 6)); + s[1] = (BYTE)(0x80 | (c & 0x3F)); + btw = 2; + } else { /* 16-bit */ + s[0] = (BYTE)(0xE0 | (c >> 12)); + s[1] = (BYTE)(0x80 | ((c >> 6) & 0x3F)); + s[2] = (BYTE)(0x80 | (c & 0x3F)); + btw = 3; + } + } +#else /* Write the character without conversion */ + s[0] = (BYTE)c; + btw = 1; +#endif + f_write(fil, s, btw, &bw); /* Write the char to the file */ + return (bw == btw) ? 1 : EOF; /* Return the result */ +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Put a string to the file */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +int f_puts ( + const TCHAR* str, /* Pointer to the string to be output */ + FIL* fil /* Pointer to the file object */ +) +{ + int n; + + + for (n = 0; *str; str++, n++) { + if (f_putc(*str, fil) == EOF) return EOF; + } + return n; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Put a formatted string to the file */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +int f_printf ( + FIL* fil, /* Pointer to the file object */ + const TCHAR* str, /* Pointer to the format string */ + ... /* Optional arguments... */ +) +{ + va_list arp; + BYTE f, r; + UINT i, j, w; + ULONG v; + TCHAR c, d, s[16], *p; + int res, chc, cc; + + + va_start(arp, str); + + for (cc = res = 0; cc != EOF; res += cc) { + c = *str++; + if (c == 0) break; /* End of string */ + if (c != '%') { /* Non escape character */ + cc = f_putc(c, fil); + if (cc != EOF) cc = 1; + continue; + } + w = f = 0; + c = *str++; + if (c == '0') { /* Flag: '0' padding */ + f = 1; c = *str++; + } else { + if (c == '-') { /* Flag: left justified */ + f = 2; c = *str++; + } + } + while (IsDigit(c)) { /* Precision */ + w = w * 10 + c - '0'; + c = *str++; + } + if (c == 'l' || c == 'L') { /* Prefix: Size is long int */ + f |= 4; c = *str++; + } + if (!c) break; + d = c; + if (IsLower(d)) d -= 0x20; + switch (d) { /* Type is... */ + case 'S' : /* String */ + p = va_arg(arp, TCHAR*); + for (j = 0; p[j]; j++) ; + chc = 0; + if (!(f & 2)) { + while (j++ < w) chc += (cc = f_putc(' ', fil)); + } + chc += (cc = f_puts(p, fil)); + while (j++ < w) chc += (cc = f_putc(' ', fil)); + if (cc != EOF) cc = chc; + continue; + case 'C' : /* Character */ + cc = f_putc((TCHAR)va_arg(arp, int), fil); continue; + case 'B' : /* Binary */ + r = 2; break; + case 'O' : /* Octal */ + r = 8; break; + case 'D' : /* Signed decimal */ + case 'U' : /* Unsigned decimal */ + r = 10; break; + case 'X' : /* Hexdecimal */ + r = 16; break; + default: /* Unknown type (pass-through) */ + cc = f_putc(c, fil); continue; + } + + /* Get an argument and put it in numeral */ + v = (f & 4) ? (ULONG)va_arg(arp, long) : ((d == 'D') ? (ULONG)(long)va_arg(arp, int) : (ULONG)va_arg(arp, unsigned int)); + if (d == 'D' && (v & 0x80000000)) { + v = 0 - v; + f |= 8; + } + i = 0; + do { + d = (TCHAR)(v % r); v /= r; + if (d > 9) d += (c == 'x') ? 0x27 : 0x07; + s[i++] = d + '0'; + } while (v && i < sizeof s / sizeof s[0]); + if (f & 8) s[i++] = '-'; + j = i; d = (f & 1) ? '0' : ' '; + res = 0; + while (!(f & 2) && j++ < w) res += (cc = f_putc(d, fil)); + do res += (cc = f_putc(s[--i], fil)); while(i); + while (j++ < w) res += (cc = f_putc(' ', fil)); + if (cc != EOF) cc = res; + } + + va_end(arp); + return (cc == EOF) ? cc : res; +} + +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ +#endif /* _USE_STRFUNC */ diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/ff.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/ff.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..627cbaabe6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/ff.h @@ -0,0 +1,337 @@ +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ FatFs - FAT file system module include file R0.09a (C)ChaN, 2012 +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ FatFs module is a generic FAT file system module for small embedded systems. +/ This is a free software that opened for education, research and commercial +/ developments under license policy of following terms. +/ +/ Copyright (C) 2012, ChaN, all right reserved. +/ +/ * The FatFs module is a free software and there is NO WARRANTY. +/ * No restriction on use. You can use, modify and redistribute it for +/ personal, non-profit or commercial product UNDER YOUR RESPONSIBILITY. +/ * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice. +/ +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#ifndef _FATFS +#define _FATFS 4004 /* Revision ID */ + +#ifdef __cplusplus +extern "C" { +#endif + +#include "integer.h" /* Basic integer types */ +#include "ffconf.h" /* FatFs configuration options */ + +#if _FATFS != _FFCONF +#error Wrong configuration file (ffconf.h). +#endif + + + +/* Definitions of volume management */ + +#if _MULTI_PARTITION /* Multiple partition configuration */ +typedef struct { + BYTE pd; /* Physical drive number */ + BYTE pt; /* Partition: 0:Auto detect, 1-4:Forced partition) */ +} PARTITION; +extern PARTITION VolToPart[]; /* Volume - Partition resolution table */ +#define LD2PD(vol) (VolToPart[vol].pd) /* Get physical drive number */ +#define LD2PT(vol) (VolToPart[vol].pt) /* Get partition index */ + +#else /* Single partition configuration */ +#define LD2PD(vol) (BYTE)(vol) /* Each logical drive is bound to the same physical drive number */ +#define LD2PT(vol) 0 /* Always mounts the 1st partition or in SFD */ + +#endif + + + +/* Type of path name strings on FatFs API */ + +#if _LFN_UNICODE /* Unicode string */ +#if !_USE_LFN +#error _LFN_UNICODE must be 0 in non-LFN cfg. +#endif +#ifndef _INC_TCHAR +typedef WCHAR TCHAR; +#define _T(x) L ## x +#define _TEXT(x) L ## x +#endif + +#else /* ANSI/OEM string */ +#ifndef _INC_TCHAR +typedef char TCHAR; +#define _T(x) x +#define _TEXT(x) x +#endif + +#endif + + + +/* File system object structure (FATFS) */ + +typedef struct { + BYTE fs_type; /* FAT sub-type (0:Not mounted) */ + BYTE drv; /* Physical drive number */ + BYTE csize; /* Sectors per cluster (1,2,4...128) */ + BYTE n_fats; /* Number of FAT copies (1,2) */ + BYTE wflag; /* win[] dirty flag (1:must be written back) */ + BYTE fsi_flag; /* fsinfo dirty flag (1:must be written back) */ + WORD id; /* File system mount ID */ + WORD n_rootdir; /* Number of root directory entries (FAT12/16) */ +#if _MAX_SS != 512 + WORD ssize; /* Bytes per sector (512, 1024, 2048 or 4096) */ +#endif +#if _FS_REENTRANT + _SYNC_t sobj; /* Identifier of sync object */ +#endif +#if !_FS_READONLY + DWORD last_clust; /* Last allocated cluster */ + DWORD free_clust; /* Number of free clusters */ + DWORD fsi_sector; /* fsinfo sector (FAT32) */ +#endif +#if _FS_RPATH + DWORD cdir; /* Current directory start cluster (0:root) */ +#endif + DWORD n_fatent; /* Number of FAT entries (= number of clusters + 2) */ + DWORD fsize; /* Sectors per FAT */ + DWORD fatbase; /* FAT start sector */ + DWORD dirbase; /* Root directory start sector (FAT32:Cluster#) */ + DWORD database; /* Data start sector */ + DWORD winsect; /* Current sector appearing in the win[] */ + BYTE win[_MAX_SS]; /* Disk access window for Directory, FAT (and Data on tiny cfg) */ +} FATFS; + + + +/* File object structure (FIL) */ + +typedef struct { + FATFS* fs; /* Pointer to the related file system object */ + WORD id; /* File system mount ID of the related file system object */ + BYTE flag; /* File status flags */ + BYTE pad1; + DWORD fptr; /* File read/write pointer (0ed on file open) */ + DWORD fsize; /* File size */ + DWORD sclust; /* File data start cluster (0:no data cluster, always 0 when fsize is 0) */ + DWORD clust; /* Current cluster of fpter */ + DWORD dsect; /* Current data sector of fpter */ +#if !_FS_READONLY + DWORD dir_sect; /* Sector containing the directory entry */ + BYTE* dir_ptr; /* Pointer to the directory entry in the window */ +#endif +#if _USE_FASTSEEK + DWORD* cltbl; /* Pointer to the cluster link map table (null on file open) */ +#endif +#if _FS_LOCK + UINT lockid; /* File lock ID (index of file semaphore table Files[]) */ +#endif +#if !_FS_TINY + BYTE buf[_MAX_SS]; /* File data read/write buffer */ +#endif +} FIL; + + + +/* Directory object structure (DIR) */ + +typedef struct { + FATFS* fs; /* Pointer to the owner file system object */ + WORD id; /* Owner file system mount ID */ + WORD index; /* Current read/write index number */ + DWORD sclust; /* Table start cluster (0:Root dir) */ + DWORD clust; /* Current cluster */ + DWORD sect; /* Current sector */ + BYTE* dir; /* Pointer to the current SFN entry in the win[] */ + BYTE* fn; /* Pointer to the SFN (in/out) {file[8],ext[3],status[1]} */ +#if _USE_LFN + WCHAR* lfn; /* Pointer to the LFN working buffer */ + WORD lfn_idx; /* Last matched LFN index number (0xFFFF:No LFN) */ +#endif +} DIR; + + + +/* File status structure (FILINFO) */ + +typedef struct { + DWORD fsize; /* File size */ + WORD fdate; /* Last modified date */ + WORD ftime; /* Last modified time */ + BYTE fattrib; /* Attribute */ + TCHAR fname[13]; /* Short file name (8.3 format) */ +#if _USE_LFN + TCHAR* lfname; /* Pointer to the LFN buffer */ + UINT lfsize; /* Size of LFN buffer in TCHAR */ +#endif +} FILINFO; + + + +/* File function return code (FRESULT) */ + +typedef enum { + FR_OK = 0, /* (0) Succeeded */ + FR_DISK_ERR, /* (1) A hard error occurred in the low level disk I/O layer */ + FR_INT_ERR, /* (2) Assertion failed */ + FR_NOT_READY, /* (3) The physical drive cannot work */ + FR_NO_FILE, /* (4) Could not find the file */ + FR_NO_PATH, /* (5) Could not find the path */ + FR_INVALID_NAME, /* (6) The path name format is invalid */ + FR_DENIED, /* (7) Access denied due to prohibited access or directory full */ + FR_EXIST, /* (8) Access denied due to prohibited access */ + FR_INVALID_OBJECT, /* (9) The file/directory object is invalid */ + FR_WRITE_PROTECTED, /* (10) The physical drive is write protected */ + FR_INVALID_DRIVE, /* (11) The logical drive number is invalid */ + FR_NOT_ENABLED, /* (12) The volume has no work area */ + FR_NO_FILESYSTEM, /* (13) There is no valid FAT volume */ + FR_MKFS_ABORTED, /* (14) The f_mkfs() aborted due to any parameter error */ + FR_TIMEOUT, /* (15) Could not get a grant to access the volume within defined period */ + FR_LOCKED, /* (16) The operation is rejected according to the file sharing policy */ + FR_NOT_ENOUGH_CORE, /* (17) LFN working buffer could not be allocated */ + FR_TOO_MANY_OPEN_FILES, /* (18) Number of open files > _FS_SHARE */ + FR_INVALID_PARAMETER /* (19) Given parameter is invalid */ +} FRESULT; + + + +/*--------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* FatFs module application interface */ + +FRESULT f_mount (BYTE, FATFS*); /* Mount/Unmount a logical drive */ +FRESULT f_open (FIL*, const TCHAR*, BYTE); /* Open or create a file */ +FRESULT f_read (FIL*, void*, UINT, UINT*); /* Read data from a file */ +FRESULT f_lseek (FIL*, DWORD); /* Move file pointer of a file object */ +FRESULT f_close (FIL*); /* Close an open file object */ +FRESULT f_opendir (DIR*, const TCHAR*); /* Open an existing directory */ +FRESULT f_readdir (DIR*, FILINFO*); /* Read a directory item */ +FRESULT f_stat (const TCHAR*, FILINFO*); /* Get file status */ +FRESULT f_write (FIL*, const void*, UINT, UINT*); /* Write data to a file */ +FRESULT f_getfree (const TCHAR*, DWORD*, FATFS**); /* Get number of free clusters on the drive */ +FRESULT f_truncate (FIL*); /* Truncate file */ +FRESULT f_sync (FIL*); /* Flush cached data of a writing file */ +FRESULT f_unlink (const TCHAR*); /* Delete an existing file or directory */ +FRESULT f_mkdir (const TCHAR*); /* Create a new directory */ +FRESULT f_chmod (const TCHAR*, BYTE, BYTE); /* Change attribute of the file/dir */ +FRESULT f_utime (const TCHAR*, const FILINFO*); /* Change times-tamp of the file/dir */ +FRESULT f_rename (const TCHAR*, const TCHAR*); /* Rename/Move a file or directory */ +FRESULT f_chdrive (BYTE); /* Change current drive */ +FRESULT f_chdir (const TCHAR*); /* Change current directory */ +FRESULT f_getcwd (TCHAR*, UINT); /* Get current directory */ +FRESULT f_forward (FIL*, UINT(*)(const BYTE*,UINT), UINT, UINT*); /* Forward data to the stream */ +FRESULT f_mkfs (BYTE, BYTE, UINT); /* Create a file system on the drive */ +FRESULT f_fdisk (BYTE, const DWORD[], void*); /* Divide a physical drive into some partitions */ +int f_putc (TCHAR, FIL*); /* Put a character to the file */ +int f_puts (const TCHAR*, FIL*); /* Put a string to the file */ +int f_printf (FIL*, const TCHAR*, ...); /* Put a formatted string to the file */ +TCHAR* f_gets (TCHAR*, int, FIL*); /* Get a string from the file */ + +#define f_eof(fp) (((fp)->fptr == (fp)->fsize) ? 1 : 0) +#define f_error(fp) (((fp)->flag & FA__ERROR) ? 1 : 0) +#define f_tell(fp) ((fp)->fptr) +#define f_size(fp) ((fp)->fsize) + +#ifndef EOF +#define EOF (-1) +#endif + + + + +/*--------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Additional user defined functions */ + +/* RTC function */ +#if !_FS_READONLY +DWORD get_fattime (void); +#endif + +/* Unicode support functions */ +#if _USE_LFN /* Unicode - OEM code conversion */ +WCHAR ff_convert (WCHAR, UINT); /* OEM-Unicode bidirectional conversion */ +WCHAR ff_wtoupper (WCHAR); /* Unicode upper-case conversion */ +#if _USE_LFN == 3 /* Memory functions */ +void* ff_memalloc (UINT); /* Allocate memory block */ +void ff_memfree (void*); /* Free memory block */ +#endif +#endif + +/* Sync functions */ +#if _FS_REENTRANT +int ff_cre_syncobj (BYTE, _SYNC_t*);/* Create a sync object */ +int ff_req_grant (_SYNC_t); /* Lock sync object */ +void ff_rel_grant (_SYNC_t); /* Unlock sync object */ +int ff_del_syncobj (_SYNC_t); /* Delete a sync object */ +#endif + + + + +/*--------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Flags and offset address */ + + +/* File access control and file status flags (FIL.flag) */ + +#define FA_READ 0x01 +#define FA_OPEN_EXISTING 0x00 +#define FA__ERROR 0x80 + +#if !_FS_READONLY +#define FA_WRITE 0x02 +#define FA_CREATE_NEW 0x04 +#define FA_CREATE_ALWAYS 0x08 +#define FA_OPEN_ALWAYS 0x10 +#define FA__WRITTEN 0x20 +#define FA__DIRTY 0x40 +#endif + + +/* FAT sub type (FATFS.fs_type) */ + +#define FS_FAT12 1 +#define FS_FAT16 2 +#define FS_FAT32 3 + + +/* File attribute bits for directory entry */ + +#define AM_RDO 0x01 /* Read only */ +#define AM_HID 0x02 /* Hidden */ +#define AM_SYS 0x04 /* System */ +#define AM_VOL 0x08 /* Volume label */ +#define AM_LFN 0x0F /* LFN entry */ +#define AM_DIR 0x10 /* Directory */ +#define AM_ARC 0x20 /* Archive */ +#define AM_MASK 0x3F /* Mask of defined bits */ + + +/* Fast seek feature */ +#define CREATE_LINKMAP 0xFFFFFFFF + + + +/*--------------------------------*/ +/* Multi-byte word access macros */ + +#if _WORD_ACCESS == 1 /* Enable word access to the FAT structure */ +#define LD_WORD(ptr) (WORD)(*(WORD*)(BYTE*)(ptr)) +#define LD_DWORD(ptr) (DWORD)(*(DWORD*)(BYTE*)(ptr)) +#define ST_WORD(ptr,val) *(WORD*)(BYTE*)(ptr)=(WORD)(val) +#define ST_DWORD(ptr,val) *(DWORD*)(BYTE*)(ptr)=(DWORD)(val) +#else /* Use byte-by-byte access to the FAT structure */ +#define LD_WORD(ptr) (WORD)(((WORD)*((BYTE*)(ptr)+1)<<8)|(WORD)*(BYTE*)(ptr)) +#define LD_DWORD(ptr) (DWORD)(((DWORD)*((BYTE*)(ptr)+3)<<24)|((DWORD)*((BYTE*)(ptr)+2)<<16)|((WORD)*((BYTE*)(ptr)+1)<<8)|*(BYTE*)(ptr)) +#define ST_WORD(ptr,val) *(BYTE*)(ptr)=(BYTE)(val); *((BYTE*)(ptr)+1)=(BYTE)((WORD)(val)>>8) +#define ST_DWORD(ptr,val) *(BYTE*)(ptr)=(BYTE)(val); *((BYTE*)(ptr)+1)=(BYTE)((WORD)(val)>>8); *((BYTE*)(ptr)+2)=(BYTE)((DWORD)(val)>>16); *((BYTE*)(ptr)+3)=(BYTE)((DWORD)(val)>>24) +#endif + +#ifdef __cplusplus +} +#endif + +#endif /* _FATFS */ diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/ffconf.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/ffconf.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..243a20fa22 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/ffconf.h @@ -0,0 +1,190 @@ +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ FatFs - FAT file system module configuration file R0.09a (C)ChaN, 2012 +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ +/ CAUTION! Do not forget to make clean the project after any changes to +/ the configuration options. +/ +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#ifndef _FFCONF +#define _FFCONF 4004 /* Revision ID */ + + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ Function and Buffer Configurations +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#define _FS_TINY 1 /* 0:Normal or 1:Tiny */ +/* When _FS_TINY is set to 1, FatFs uses the sector buffer in the file system +/ object instead of the sector buffer in the individual file object for file +/ data transfer. This reduces memory consumption 512 bytes each file object. */ + + +#define _FS_READONLY 1 /* 0:Read/Write or 1:Read only */ +/* Setting _FS_READONLY to 1 defines read only configuration. This removes +/ writing functions, f_write, f_sync, f_unlink, f_mkdir, f_chmod, f_rename, +/ f_truncate and useless f_getfree. */ + + +#define _FS_MINIMIZE 2 /* 0 to 3 */ +/* The _FS_MINIMIZE option defines minimization level to remove some functions. +/ +/ 0: Full function. +/ 1: f_stat, f_getfree, f_unlink, f_mkdir, f_chmod, f_truncate and f_rename +/ are removed. +/ 2: f_opendir and f_readdir are removed in addition to 1. +/ 3: f_lseek is removed in addition to 2. */ + + +#define _USE_STRFUNC 0 /* 0:Disable or 1-2:Enable */ +/* To enable string functions, set _USE_STRFUNC to 1 or 2. */ + + +#define _USE_MKFS 0 /* 0:Disable or 1:Enable */ +/* To enable f_mkfs function, set _USE_MKFS to 1 and set _FS_READONLY to 0 */ + + +#define _USE_FORWARD 0 /* 0:Disable or 1:Enable */ +/* To enable f_forward function, set _USE_FORWARD to 1 and set _FS_TINY to 1. */ + + +#define _USE_FASTSEEK 0 /* 0:Disable or 1:Enable */ +/* To enable fast seek feature, set _USE_FASTSEEK to 1. */ + + + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ Locale and Namespace Configurations +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#define _CODE_PAGE 932 +/* The _CODE_PAGE specifies the OEM code page to be used on the target system. +/ Incorrect setting of the code page can cause a file open failure. +/ +/ 932 - Japanese Shift-JIS (DBCS, OEM, Windows) +/ 936 - Simplified Chinese GBK (DBCS, OEM, Windows) +/ 949 - Korean (DBCS, OEM, Windows) +/ 950 - Traditional Chinese Big5 (DBCS, OEM, Windows) +/ 1250 - Central Europe (Windows) +/ 1251 - Cyrillic (Windows) +/ 1252 - Latin 1 (Windows) +/ 1253 - Greek (Windows) +/ 1254 - Turkish (Windows) +/ 1255 - Hebrew (Windows) +/ 1256 - Arabic (Windows) +/ 1257 - Baltic (Windows) +/ 1258 - Vietnam (OEM, Windows) +/ 437 - U.S. (OEM) +/ 720 - Arabic (OEM) +/ 737 - Greek (OEM) +/ 775 - Baltic (OEM) +/ 850 - Multilingual Latin 1 (OEM) +/ 858 - Multilingual Latin 1 + Euro (OEM) +/ 852 - Latin 2 (OEM) +/ 855 - Cyrillic (OEM) +/ 866 - Russian (OEM) +/ 857 - Turkish (OEM) +/ 862 - Hebrew (OEM) +/ 874 - Thai (OEM, Windows) +/ 1 - ASCII only (Valid for non LFN cfg.) +*/ + + +#define _USE_LFN 0 /* 0 to 3 */ +#define _MAX_LFN 255 /* Maximum LFN length to handle (12 to 255) */ +/* The _USE_LFN option switches the LFN support. +/ +/ 0: Disable LFN feature. _MAX_LFN and _LFN_UNICODE have no effect. +/ 1: Enable LFN with static working buffer on the BSS. Always NOT reentrant. +/ 2: Enable LFN with dynamic working buffer on the STACK. +/ 3: Enable LFN with dynamic working buffer on the HEAP. +/ +/ The LFN working buffer occupies (_MAX_LFN + 1) * 2 bytes. To enable LFN, +/ Unicode handling functions ff_convert() and ff_wtoupper() must be added +/ to the project. When enable to use heap, memory control functions +/ ff_memalloc() and ff_memfree() must be added to the project. */ + + +#define _LFN_UNICODE 0 /* 0:ANSI/OEM or 1:Unicode */ +/* To switch the character code set on FatFs API to Unicode, +/ enable LFN feature and set _LFN_UNICODE to 1. */ + + +#define _FS_RPATH 0 /* 0 to 2 */ +/* The _FS_RPATH option configures relative path feature. +/ +/ 0: Disable relative path feature and remove related functions. +/ 1: Enable relative path. f_chdrive() and f_chdir() are available. +/ 2: f_getcwd() is available in addition to 1. +/ +/ Note that output of the f_readdir function is affected by this option. */ + + + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ Physical Drive Configurations +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#define _VOLUMES 1 +/* Number of volumes (logical drives) to be used. */ + + +#define _MAX_SS 512 /* 512, 1024, 2048 or 4096 */ +/* Maximum sector size to be handled. +/ Always set 512 for memory card and hard disk but a larger value may be +/ required for on-board flash memory, floppy disk and optical disk. +/ When _MAX_SS is larger than 512, it configures FatFs to variable sector size +/ and GET_SECTOR_SIZE command must be implemented to the disk_ioctl function. */ + + +#define _MULTI_PARTITION 0 /* 0:Single partition, 1/2:Enable multiple partition */ +/* When set to 0, each volume is bound to the same physical drive number and +/ it can mount only first primary partition. When it is set to 1, each volume +/ is tied to the partitions listed in VolToPart[]. */ + + +#define _USE_ERASE 0 /* 0:Disable or 1:Enable */ +/* To enable sector erase feature, set _USE_ERASE to 1. CTRL_ERASE_SECTOR command +/ should be added to the disk_ioctl function. */ + + + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ System Configurations +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#define _WORD_ACCESS 1 /* 0 or 1 */ +/* Set 0 first and it is always compatible with all platforms. The _WORD_ACCESS +/ option defines which access method is used to the word data on the FAT volume. +/ +/ 0: Byte-by-byte access. +/ 1: Word access. Do not choose this unless following condition is met. +/ +/ When the byte order on the memory is big-endian or address miss-aligned word +/ access results incorrect behavior, the _WORD_ACCESS must be set to 0. +/ If it is not the case, the value can also be set to 1 to improve the +/ performance and code size. */ + + +/* A header file that defines sync object types on the O/S, such as +/ windows.h, ucos_ii.h and semphr.h, must be included prior to ff.h. */ + +#define _FS_REENTRANT 0 /* 0:Disable or 1:Enable */ +#define _FS_TIMEOUT 1000 /* Timeout period in unit of time ticks */ +#define _SYNC_t HANDLE /* O/S dependent type of sync object. e.g. HANDLE, OS_EVENT*, ID and etc.. */ + +/* The _FS_REENTRANT option switches the reentrancy (thread safe) of the FatFs module. +/ +/ 0: Disable reentrancy. _SYNC_t and _FS_TIMEOUT have no effect. +/ 1: Enable reentrancy. Also user provided synchronization handlers, +/ ff_req_grant, ff_rel_grant, ff_del_syncobj and ff_cre_syncobj +/ function must be added to the project. */ + + +#define _FS_LOCK 0 /* 0:Disable or >=1:Enable */ +/* To enable file lock control feature, set _FS_LOCK to 1 or greater. + The value defines how many files can be opened simultaneously. */ + + +#endif /* _FFCONFIG */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/integer.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/integer.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5408fe6b3e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/integer.h @@ -0,0 +1,38 @@ +/*-------------------------------------------*/ +/* Integer type definitions for FatFs module */ +/*-------------------------------------------*/ + +#ifndef _INTEGER +#define _INTEGER + +#ifdef _WIN32 /* FatFs development platform */ + +#include <windows.h> +#include <tchar.h> + +#else /* Embedded platform */ + +/* These types must be 16-bit, 32-bit or larger integer */ +typedef int INT; +typedef unsigned int UINT; + +/* These types must be 8-bit integer */ +typedef char CHAR; +typedef unsigned char UCHAR; +typedef unsigned char BYTE; + +/* These types must be 16-bit integer */ +typedef short SHORT; +typedef unsigned short USHORT; +typedef unsigned short WORD; +typedef unsigned short WCHAR; + +/* These types must be 32-bit integer */ +typedef long LONG; +typedef unsigned long ULONG; +typedef unsigned long DWORD; + +#endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/HTTPServerApp.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/HTTPServerApp.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ba5ce8b995 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/HTTPServerApp.c @@ -0,0 +1,284 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Simple HTTP Webserver Application. When connected to the uIP stack, + * this will serve out files to HTTP clients on port 80. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_HTTPSERVERAPP_C +#include "HTTPServerApp.h" + +/** HTTP server response header, for transmission before the page contents. This indicates to the host that a page exists at the + * given location, and gives extra connection information. + */ +const char PROGMEM HTTP200Header[] = "HTTP/1.1 200 OK\r\n" + "Server: LUFA " LUFA_VERSION_STRING "\r\n" + "Connection: close\r\n" + "MIME-version: 1.0\r\n" + "Content-Type: "; + +/** HTTP server response header, for transmission before a resource not found error. This indicates to the host that the given + * URL is invalid, and gives extra error information. + */ +const char PROGMEM HTTP404Header[] = "HTTP/1.1 404 Not Found\r\n" + "Server: LUFA " LUFA_VERSION_STRING "\r\n" + "Connection: close\r\n" + "MIME-version: 1.0\r\n" + "Content-Type: text/plain\r\n\r\n" + "Error 404: File Not Found: /"; + +/** Default filename to fetch when a directory is requested */ +const char PROGMEM DefaultDirFileName[] = "index.htm"; + +/** Default MIME type sent if no other MIME type can be determined. */ +const char PROGMEM DefaultMIMEType[] = "text/plain"; + +/** List of MIME types for each supported file extension. */ +const MIME_Type_t MIMETypes[] = + { + {.Extension = "htm", .MIMEType = "text/html"}, + {.Extension = "jpg", .MIMEType = "image/jpeg"}, + {.Extension = "gif", .MIMEType = "image/gif"}, + {.Extension = "bmp", .MIMEType = "image/bmp"}, + {.Extension = "png", .MIMEType = "image/png"}, + {.Extension = "ico", .MIMEType = "image/x-icon"}, + {.Extension = "exe", .MIMEType = "application/octet-stream"}, + {.Extension = "gz", .MIMEType = "application/x-gzip"}, + {.Extension = "zip", .MIMEType = "application/zip"}, + {.Extension = "pdf", .MIMEType = "application/pdf"}, + }; + +/** FATFs structure to hold the internal state of the FAT driver for the Dataflash contents. */ +FATFS DiskFATState; + + +/** Initialization function for the simple HTTP webserver. */ +void HTTPServerApp_Init(void) +{ + /* Listen on port 80 for HTTP connections from hosts */ + uip_listen(HTONS(HTTP_SERVER_PORT)); + + /* Mount the Dataflash disk via FatFS */ + f_mount(0, &DiskFATState); +} + +/** uIP stack application callback for the simple HTTP webserver. This function must be called each time the + * TCP/IP stack needs a TCP packet to be processed. + */ +void HTTPServerApp_Callback(void) +{ + uip_tcp_appstate_t* const AppState = &uip_conn->appstate; + + if (uip_aborted() || uip_timedout() || uip_closed()) + { + /* Lock to the closed state so that no further processing will occur on the connection */ + AppState->HTTPServer.CurrentState = WEBSERVER_STATE_Closing; + AppState->HTTPServer.NextState = WEBSERVER_STATE_Closing; + } + + if (uip_connected()) + { + /* New connection - initialize connection state values */ + AppState->HTTPServer.CurrentState = WEBSERVER_STATE_OpenRequestedFile; + AppState->HTTPServer.NextState = WEBSERVER_STATE_OpenRequestedFile; + AppState->HTTPServer.FileOpen = false; + AppState->HTTPServer.ACKedFilePos = 0; + AppState->HTTPServer.SentChunkSize = 0; + } + + if (uip_acked()) + { + /* Add the amount of ACKed file data to the total sent file bytes counter */ + AppState->HTTPServer.ACKedFilePos += AppState->HTTPServer.SentChunkSize; + + /* Progress to the next state once the current state's data has been ACKed */ + AppState->HTTPServer.CurrentState = AppState->HTTPServer.NextState; + } + + if (uip_rexmit()) + { + /* Return file pointer to the last ACKed position */ + f_lseek(&AppState->HTTPServer.FileHandle, AppState->HTTPServer.ACKedFilePos); + } + + if (uip_rexmit() || uip_acked() || uip_newdata() || uip_connected() || uip_poll()) + { + switch (AppState->HTTPServer.CurrentState) + { + case WEBSERVER_STATE_OpenRequestedFile: + HTTPServerApp_OpenRequestedFile(); + break; + case WEBSERVER_STATE_SendResponseHeader: + HTTPServerApp_SendResponseHeader(); + break; + case WEBSERVER_STATE_SendData: + HTTPServerApp_SendData(); + break; + case WEBSERVER_STATE_Closing: + /* Connection is being terminated for some reason - close file handle */ + f_close(&AppState->HTTPServer.FileHandle); + AppState->HTTPServer.FileOpen = false; + + /* If connection is not already closed, close it */ + uip_close(); + + AppState->HTTPServer.CurrentState = WEBSERVER_STATE_Closed; + AppState->HTTPServer.NextState = WEBSERVER_STATE_Closed; + break; + } + } +} + +/** HTTP Server State handler for the Request Process state. This state manages the processing of incoming HTTP + * GET requests to the server from the receiving HTTP client. + */ +static void HTTPServerApp_OpenRequestedFile(void) +{ + uip_tcp_appstate_t* const AppState = &uip_conn->appstate; + char* const AppData = (char*)uip_appdata; + + /* No HTTP header received from the client, abort processing */ + if (!(uip_newdata())) + return; + + char* RequestToken = strtok(AppData, " "); + char* RequestedFileName = strtok(NULL, " "); + + /* Must be a GET request, abort otherwise */ + if (strcmp_P(RequestToken, PSTR("GET")) != 0) + { + uip_abort(); + return; + } + + /* Copy over the requested filename */ + strlcpy(AppState->HTTPServer.FileName, &RequestedFileName[1], sizeof(AppState->HTTPServer.FileName)); + + /* Determine the length of the URI so that it can be checked to see if it is a directory */ + uint8_t FileNameLen = strlen(AppState->HTTPServer.FileName); + + /* If the URI is a directory, append the default filename */ + if ((AppState->HTTPServer.FileName[FileNameLen - 1] == '/') || !(FileNameLen)) + { + strlcpy_P(&AppState->HTTPServer.FileName[FileNameLen], DefaultDirFileName, + (sizeof(AppState->HTTPServer.FileName) - FileNameLen)); + } + + /* Try to open the file from the Dataflash disk */ + AppState->HTTPServer.FileOpen = (f_open(&AppState->HTTPServer.FileHandle, AppState->HTTPServer.FileName, + (FA_OPEN_EXISTING | FA_READ)) == FR_OK); + + /* Lock to the SendResponseHeader state until connection terminated */ + AppState->HTTPServer.CurrentState = WEBSERVER_STATE_SendResponseHeader; + AppState->HTTPServer.NextState = WEBSERVER_STATE_SendResponseHeader; +} + +/** HTTP Server State handler for the HTTP Response Header Send state. This state manages the transmission of + * the HTTP response header to the receiving HTTP client. + */ +static void HTTPServerApp_SendResponseHeader(void) +{ + uip_tcp_appstate_t* const AppState = &uip_conn->appstate; + char* const AppData = (char*)uip_appdata; + + char* Extension = strpbrk(AppState->HTTPServer.FileName, "."); + bool FoundMIMEType = false; + + /* If the file isn't already open, it wasn't found - send back a 404 error response and abort */ + if (!(AppState->HTTPServer.FileOpen)) + { + /* Copy over the HTTP 404 response header and send it to the receiving client */ + strcpy_P(AppData, HTTP404Header); + strcat(AppData, AppState->HTTPServer.FileName); + uip_send(AppData, strlen(AppData)); + + AppState->HTTPServer.NextState = WEBSERVER_STATE_Closing; + return; + } + + /* Copy over the HTTP 200 response header and send it to the receiving client */ + strcpy_P(AppData, HTTP200Header); + + /* Check to see if a MIME type for the requested file's extension was found */ + if (Extension != NULL) + { + /* Look through the MIME type list, copy over the required MIME type if found */ + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < (sizeof(MIMETypes) / sizeof(MIMETypes[0])); i++) + { + if (strcmp(&Extension[1], MIMETypes[i].Extension) == 0) + { + strcat(AppData, MIMETypes[i].MIMEType); + FoundMIMEType = true; + break; + } + } + } + + /* Check if a MIME type was found and copied to the output buffer */ + if (!(FoundMIMEType)) + { + /* MIME type not found - copy over the default MIME type */ + strcat_P(AppData, DefaultMIMEType); + } + + /* Add the end-of-line terminator and end-of-headers terminator after the MIME type */ + strcat_P(AppData, PSTR("\r\n\r\n")); + + /* Send the MIME header to the receiving client */ + uip_send(AppData, strlen(AppData)); + + /* When the MIME header is ACKed, progress to the data send stage */ + AppState->HTTPServer.NextState = WEBSERVER_STATE_SendData; +} + +/** HTTP Server State handler for the Data Send state. This state manages the transmission of file chunks + * to the receiving HTTP client. + */ +static void HTTPServerApp_SendData(void) +{ + uip_tcp_appstate_t* const AppState = &uip_conn->appstate; + char* const AppData = (char*)uip_appdata; + + /* Get the maximum segment size for the current packet */ + uint16_t MaxChunkSize = uip_mss(); + + /* Read the next chunk of data from the open file */ + f_read(&AppState->HTTPServer.FileHandle, AppData, MaxChunkSize, &AppState->HTTPServer.SentChunkSize); + + /* Send the next file chunk to the receiving client */ + uip_send(AppData, AppState->HTTPServer.SentChunkSize); + + /* Check if we are at the last chunk of the file, if so next ACK should close the connection */ + if (MaxChunkSize != AppState->HTTPServer.SentChunkSize) + AppState->HTTPServer.NextState = WEBSERVER_STATE_Closing; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/HTTPServerApp.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/HTTPServerApp.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..11c39d87ed --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/HTTPServerApp.h @@ -0,0 +1,84 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for HTTPServerApp.c. + */ + +#ifndef _HTTPSERVER_APP_H_ +#define _HTTPSERVER_APP_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <string.h> + + #include <LUFA/Version.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <uip.h> + #include <ff.h> + + /* Enums: */ + /** States for each HTTP connection to the webserver. */ + enum Webserver_States_t + { + WEBSERVER_STATE_OpenRequestedFile, /**< Currently opening requested file */ + WEBSERVER_STATE_SendResponseHeader, /**< Currently sending HTTP response headers to the client */ + WEBSERVER_STATE_SendData, /**< Currently sending HTTP page data to the client */ + WEBSERVER_STATE_Closing, /**< Ready to close the connection to the client */ + WEBSERVER_STATE_Closed, /**< Connection closed after all data sent */ + }; + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for a MIME type handler. */ + typedef struct + { + char* Extension; /**< File extension (no leading '.' character) */ + char* MIMEType; /**< Appropriate MIME type to send when the extension is encountered */ + } MIME_Type_t; + + /* Macros: */ + /** TCP listen port for incoming HTTP traffic. */ + #define HTTP_SERVER_PORT 80 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void HTTPServerApp_Init(void); + void HTTPServerApp_Callback(void); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_HTTPSERVERAPP_C) + static void HTTPServerApp_OpenRequestedFile(void); + static void HTTPServerApp_SendResponseHeader(void); + static void HTTPServerApp_SendData(void); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/SCSI.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/SCSI.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4fbbfd60e8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/SCSI.c @@ -0,0 +1,344 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * SCSI command processing routines, for SCSI commands issued by the host. Mass Storage + * devices use a thin "Bulk-Only Transport" protocol for issuing commands and status information, + * which wrap around standard SCSI device commands for controlling the actual storage medium. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_SCSI_C +#include "SCSI.h" + +/** Structure to hold the SCSI response data to a SCSI INQUIRY command. This gives information about the device's + * features and capabilities. + */ +static const SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t InquiryData = + { + .DeviceType = DEVICE_TYPE_BLOCK, + .PeripheralQualifier = 0, + + .Removable = true, + + .Version = 0, + + .ResponseDataFormat = 2, + .NormACA = false, + .TrmTsk = false, + .AERC = false, + + .AdditionalLength = 0x1F, + + .SoftReset = false, + .CmdQue = false, + .Linked = false, + .Sync = false, + .WideBus16Bit = false, + .WideBus32Bit = false, + .RelAddr = false, + + .VendorID = "LUFA", + .ProductID = "Dataflash Disk", + .RevisionID = {'0','.','0','0'}, + }; + +/** Structure to hold the sense data for the last issued SCSI command, which is returned to the host after a SCSI REQUEST SENSE + * command is issued. This gives information on exactly why the last command failed to complete. + */ +static SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t SenseData = + { + .ResponseCode = 0x70, + .AdditionalLength = 0x0A, + }; + + +/** Main routine to process the SCSI command located in the Command Block Wrapper read from the host. This dispatches + * to the appropriate SCSI command handling routine if the issued command is supported by the device, else it returns + * a command failure due to a ILLEGAL REQUEST. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise + */ +bool SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + bool CommandSuccess = false; + + /* Run the appropriate SCSI command hander function based on the passed command */ + switch (MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[0]) + { + case SCSI_CMD_INQUIRY: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Inquiry(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_REQUEST_SENSE: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_READ_CAPACITY_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_SEND_DIAGNOSTIC: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_WRITE_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(MSInterfaceInfo, DATA_WRITE); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_READ_10: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(MSInterfaceInfo, DATA_READ); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_MODE_SENSE_6: + CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(MSInterfaceInfo); + break; + case SCSI_CMD_START_STOP_UNIT: + case SCSI_CMD_TEST_UNIT_READY: + case SCSI_CMD_PREVENT_ALLOW_MEDIUM_REMOVAL: + case SCSI_CMD_VERIFY_10: + /* These commands should just succeed, no handling required */ + CommandSuccess = true; + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength = 0; + break; + default: + /* Update the SENSE key to reflect the invalid command */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_COMMAND, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + break; + } + + /* Check if command was successfully processed */ + if (CommandSuccess) + { + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_GOOD, + SCSI_ASENSE_NO_ADDITIONAL_INFORMATION, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return true; + } + + return false; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI INQUIRY command. This command returns information about the device's features + * and capabilities to the host. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Inquiry(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint16_t AllocationLength = SwapEndian_16(*(uint16_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[3]); + uint16_t BytesTransferred = MIN(AllocationLength, sizeof(InquiryData)); + + /* Only the standard INQUIRY data is supported, check if any optional INQUIRY bits set */ + if ((MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[1] & ((1 << 0) | (1 << 1))) || + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[2]) + { + /* Optional but unsupported bits set - update the SENSE key and fail the request */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_FIELD_IN_CDB, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&InquiryData, BytesTransferred, NULL); + + /* Pad out remaining bytes with 0x00 */ + Endpoint_Null_Stream((AllocationLength - BytesTransferred), NULL); + + /* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= BytesTransferred; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI REQUEST SENSE command. This command returns information about the last issued command, + * including the error code and additional error information so that the host can determine why a command failed to complete. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint8_t AllocationLength = MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[4]; + uint8_t BytesTransferred = MIN(AllocationLength, sizeof(SenseData)); + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&SenseData, BytesTransferred, NULL); + Endpoint_Null_Stream((AllocationLength - BytesTransferred), NULL); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= BytesTransferred; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI READ CAPACITY (10) command. This command returns information about the device's capacity + * on the selected Logical Unit (drive), as a number of OS-sized blocks. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + uint32_t LastBlockAddressInLUN = (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCKS - 1); + uint32_t MediaBlockSize = VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE; + + Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE(&LastBlockAddressInLUN, sizeof(LastBlockAddressInLUN), NULL); + Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE(&MediaBlockSize, sizeof(MediaBlockSize), NULL); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= 8; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI SEND DIAGNOSTIC command. This command performs a quick check of the Dataflash ICs on the + * board, and indicates if they are present and functioning correctly. Only the Self-Test portion of the diagnostic command is + * supported. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + /* Check to see if the SELF TEST bit is not set */ + if (!(MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[1] & (1 << 2))) + { + /* Only self-test supported - update SENSE key and fail the command */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_FIELD_IN_CDB, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Check to see if all attached Dataflash ICs are functional */ + if (!(DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation())) + { + /* Update SENSE key with a hardware error condition and return command fail */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_HARDWARE_ERROR, + SCSI_ASENSE_NO_ADDITIONAL_INFORMATION, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength = 0; + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI READ (10) or WRITE (10) command. This command reads in the block start address + * and total number of blocks to process, then calls the appropriate low-level Dataflash routine to handle the actual + * reading and writing of the data. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * \param[in] IsDataRead Indicates if the command is a READ (10) command or WRITE (10) command (DATA_READ or DATA_WRITE) + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const bool IsDataRead) +{ + uint32_t BlockAddress; + uint16_t TotalBlocks; + + /* Check if the disk is write protected or not */ + if ((IsDataRead == DATA_WRITE) && DISK_READ_ONLY) + { + /* Block address is invalid, update SENSE key and return command fail */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_DATA_PROTECT, + SCSI_ASENSE_WRITE_PROTECTED, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Load in the 32-bit block address (SCSI uses big-endian, so have to reverse the byte order) */ + BlockAddress = SwapEndian_32(*(uint32_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[2]); + + /* Load in the 16-bit total blocks (SCSI uses big-endian, so have to reverse the byte order) */ + TotalBlocks = SwapEndian_16(*(uint16_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[7]); + + /* Check if the block address is outside the maximum allowable value for the LUN */ + if (BlockAddress >= VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCKS) + { + /* Block address is invalid, update SENSE key and return command fail */ + SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, + SCSI_ASENSE_LOGICAL_BLOCK_ADDRESS_OUT_OF_RANGE, + SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + + return false; + } + + /* Determine if the packet is a READ (10) or WRITE (10) command, call appropriate function */ + if (IsDataRead == DATA_READ) + DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(MSInterfaceInfo, BlockAddress, TotalBlocks); + else + DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(MSInterfaceInfo, BlockAddress, TotalBlocks); + + /* Update the bytes transferred counter and succeed the command */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= ((uint32_t)TotalBlocks * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE); + + return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI MODE SENSE (6) command. This command returns various informational pages about + * the SCSI device, as well as the device's Write Protect status. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + * \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + /* Send an empty header response with the Write Protect flag status */ + Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); + Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); + Endpoint_Write_8(DISK_READ_ONLY ? 0x80 : 0x00); + Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); + Endpoint_ClearIN(); + + /* Update the bytes transferred counter and succeed the command */ + MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= 4; + + return true; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/SCSI.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/SCSI.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8f41f63b43 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/SCSI.h @@ -0,0 +1,87 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for SCSI.c. + */ + +#ifndef _SCSI_H_ +#define _SCSI_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "../Descriptors.h" + #include "DataflashManager.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Macro to set the current SCSI sense data to the given key, additional sense code and additional sense qualifier. This + * is for convenience, as it allows for all three sense values (returned upon request to the host to give information about + * the last command failure) in a quick and easy manner. + * + * \param[in] Key New SCSI sense key to set the sense code to + * \param[in] Acode New SCSI additional sense key to set the additional sense code to + * \param[in] Aqual New SCSI additional sense key qualifier to set the additional sense qualifier code to + */ + #define SCSI_SET_SENSE(Key, Acode, Aqual) do { SenseData.SenseKey = (Key); \ + SenseData.AdditionalSenseCode = (Acode); \ + SenseData.AdditionalSenseQualifier = (Aqual); } while (0) + + /** Macro for the \ref SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10() function, to indicate that data is to be read from the storage medium. */ + #define DATA_READ true + + /** Macro for the \ref SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10() function, to indicate that data is to be written to the storage medium. */ + #define DATA_WRITE false + + /** Value for the DeviceType entry in the SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t enum, indicating a Block Media device. */ + #define DEVICE_TYPE_BLOCK 0x00 + + /** Value for the DeviceType entry in the SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t enum, indicating a CD-ROM device. */ + #define DEVICE_TYPE_CDROM 0x05 + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + bool SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_SCSI_C) + static bool SCSI_Command_Inquiry(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + static bool SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, + const bool IsDataRead); + static bool SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/TELNETServerApp.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/TELNETServerApp.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4500a4b781 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/TELNETServerApp.c @@ -0,0 +1,163 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * TELNET Webserver Application. When connected to the uIP stack, + * this will serve out raw TELNET to the client on port 23. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_TELNETSERVERAPP_C +#include "TELNETServerApp.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_TELNET_SERVER) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + +/** Welcome message to send to a TELNET client when a connection is first made. */ +const char PROGMEM WelcomeHeader[] = "********************************************\r\n" + "* LUFA uIP Webserver (TELNET) *\r\n" + "********************************************\r\n"; + +/** Main TELNET menu, giving the user the list of available commands they may issue */ +const char PROGMEM TELNETMenu[] = "\r\n" + " == Available Commands: ==\r\n" + " c) List Active TCP Connections\r\n" + " =========================\r\n" + "\r\n>"; + +/** Header to print before the current connections are printed to the client */ +const char PROGMEM CurrentConnectionsHeader[] = "\r\n* Current TCP Connections: *\r\n"; + +/** Initialization function for the simple TELNET webserver. */ +void TELNETServerApp_Init(void) +{ + /* Listen on port 23 for TELNET connections from hosts */ + uip_listen(HTONS(TELNET_SERVER_PORT)); +} + +/** uIP stack application callback for the TELNET server. This function must be called each time the + * TCP/IP stack needs a TCP packet to be processed. + */ +void TELNETServerApp_Callback(void) +{ + uip_tcp_appstate_t* const AppState = &uip_conn->appstate; + char* const AppData = (char*)uip_appdata; + + if (uip_connected()) + { + /* New connection - initialize connection state values */ + AppState->TELNETServer.CurrentState = TELNET_STATE_SendHeader; + } + + if (uip_acked()) + { + /* Progress to the next state once the current state's data has been ACKed */ + AppState->TELNETServer.CurrentState = AppState->TELNETServer.NextState; + } + + if (uip_rexmit() || uip_acked() || uip_newdata() || uip_connected() || uip_poll()) + { + switch (AppState->TELNETServer.CurrentState) + { + case TELNET_STATE_SendHeader: + /* Copy over and send the TELNET welcome message upon first connection */ + strcpy_P(AppData, WelcomeHeader); + uip_send(AppData, strlen(AppData)); + + AppState->TELNETServer.NextState = TELNET_STATE_SendMenu; + break; + case TELNET_STATE_SendMenu: + /* Copy over and send the TELNET menu to the client */ + strcpy_P(AppData, TELNETMenu); + uip_send(AppData, strlen(AppData)); + + AppState->TELNETServer.NextState = TELNET_STATE_GetCommand; + break; + case TELNET_STATE_GetCommand: + if (!(uip_datalen())) + break; + + /* Save the issued command for later processing */ + AppState->TELNETServer.IssuedCommand = AppData[0]; + + AppState->TELNETServer.CurrentState = TELNET_STATE_SendResponse; + break; + case TELNET_STATE_SendResponse: + /* Determine which command was issued, perform command processing */ + switch (AppState->TELNETServer.IssuedCommand) + { + case 'c': + TELNETServerApp_DisplayTCPConnections(); + break; + default: + strcpy_P(AppData, PSTR("Invalid Command.\r\n")); + uip_send(AppData, strlen(AppData)); + break; + } + + AppState->TELNETServer.NextState = TELNET_STATE_SendMenu; + break; + } + } +} + +/** Sends a list of active TCP connections to the TELNET client. */ +static void TELNETServerApp_DisplayTCPConnections(void) +{ + char* const AppData = (char*)uip_appdata; + + strcpy_P(AppData, CurrentConnectionsHeader); + + uint16_t ResponseLen = strlen(AppData); + uint8_t ActiveConnCount = 0; + + /* Loop through the complete uIP TCP connections list, looking for active connections */ + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < UIP_CONNS; i++) + { + struct uip_conn* CurrConnection = &uip_conns[i]; + + /* If the connection is not closed, it is active and must be added to the out buffer */ + if (CurrConnection->tcpstateflags != UIP_CLOSED) + { + /* Add the current connection's details to the out buffer */ + ResponseLen += sprintf_P(&AppData[ResponseLen], PSTR("%u) %d.%d.%d.%d (Local Port %u <=> Remote Port %u)\r\n"), + ++ActiveConnCount, + CurrConnection->ripaddr.u8[0], + CurrConnection->ripaddr.u8[1], + CurrConnection->ripaddr.u8[2], + CurrConnection->ripaddr.u8[3], + HTONS(CurrConnection->lport), HTONS(CurrConnection->rport)); + } + } + + uip_send(AppData, ResponseLen); +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/TELNETServerApp.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/TELNETServerApp.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..67301ba09c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/TELNETServerApp.h @@ -0,0 +1,71 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for TELNETServerApp.c. + */ + +#ifndef _TELNETSERVER_APP_H_ +#define _TELNETSERVER_APP_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <string.h> + #include <stdio.h> + + #include <uip.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** TCP listen port for incoming TELNET traffic. */ + #define TELNET_SERVER_PORT 23 + + /* Enums: */ + /** States for each TELNET connection to the server. */ + enum TELNET_States_t + { + TELNET_STATE_SendHeader, /**< Currently sending welcome header to the client */ + TELNET_STATE_SendMenu, /**< Currently sending the command list menu to the client */ + TELNET_STATE_GetCommand, /**< Currently waiting for a command from the client */ + TELNET_STATE_SendResponse, /**< Processing the issued command and sending a response */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void TELNETServerApp_Init(void); + void TELNETServerApp_Callback(void); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_TELNETSERVERAPP_C) + static void TELNETServerApp_DisplayTCPConnections(void); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uIPManagement.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uIPManagement.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..12f6c8f9e7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uIPManagement.c @@ -0,0 +1,298 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * uIP Management functions. This file contains the functions and globals needed to maintain the uIP + * stack once an RNDIS device has been attached to the system. + */ + +#define INCLUDE_FROM_UIPMANAGEMENT_C +#include "uIPManagement.h" + +/** Connection timer, to retain the time elapsed since the last time the uIP connections were managed. */ +static struct timer ConnectionTimer; + +/** ARP timer, to retain the time elapsed since the ARP cache was last updated. */ +static struct timer ARPTimer; + +/** MAC address of the RNDIS device, when enumerated. */ +struct uip_eth_addr MACAddress; + + +/** Configures the uIP stack ready for network traffic processing. */ +void uIPManagement_Init(void) +{ + /* uIP Timing Initialization */ + clock_init(); + timer_set(&ConnectionTimer, CLOCK_SECOND / 2); + timer_set(&ARPTimer, CLOCK_SECOND * 10); + + /* uIP Stack Initialization */ + uip_init(); + uip_arp_init(); + + /* DHCP/Server IP Settings Initialization */ + if (USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Device) + { + MACAddress.addr[0] = SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS[0]; + MACAddress.addr[1] = SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS[1]; + MACAddress.addr[2] = SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS[2]; + MACAddress.addr[3] = SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS[3]; + MACAddress.addr[4] = SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS[4]; + MACAddress.addr[5] = SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS[5]; + + #if defined(ENABLE_DHCP_SERVER) + DHCPServerApp_Init(); + #endif + + uip_ipaddr_t IPAddress, Netmask, GatewayIPAddress; + uip_ipaddr(&IPAddress, DEVICE_IP_ADDRESS[0], DEVICE_IP_ADDRESS[1], DEVICE_IP_ADDRESS[2], DEVICE_IP_ADDRESS[3]); + uip_ipaddr(&Netmask, DEVICE_NETMASK[0], DEVICE_NETMASK[1], DEVICE_NETMASK[2], DEVICE_NETMASK[3]); + uip_ipaddr(&GatewayIPAddress, DEVICE_GATEWAY[0], DEVICE_GATEWAY[1], DEVICE_GATEWAY[2], DEVICE_GATEWAY[3]); + uip_sethostaddr(&IPAddress); + uip_setnetmask(&Netmask); + uip_setdraddr(&GatewayIPAddress); + } + else + { + #if defined(ENABLE_DHCP_CLIENT) + DHCPClientApp_Init(); + #else + uip_ipaddr_t IPAddress, Netmask, GatewayIPAddress; + uip_ipaddr(&IPAddress, DEVICE_IP_ADDRESS[0], DEVICE_IP_ADDRESS[1], DEVICE_IP_ADDRESS[2], DEVICE_IP_ADDRESS[3]); + uip_ipaddr(&Netmask, DEVICE_NETMASK[0], DEVICE_NETMASK[1], DEVICE_NETMASK[2], DEVICE_NETMASK[3]); + uip_ipaddr(&GatewayIPAddress, DEVICE_GATEWAY[0], DEVICE_GATEWAY[1], DEVICE_GATEWAY[2], DEVICE_GATEWAY[3]); + uip_sethostaddr(&IPAddress); + uip_setnetmask(&Netmask); + uip_setdraddr(&GatewayIPAddress); + #endif + } + + /* Virtual Webserver Ethernet Address Configuration */ + uip_setethaddr(MACAddress); + + /* HTTP Webserver Initialization */ + HTTPServerApp_Init(); + + /* TELNET Server Initialization */ + #if defined(ENABLE_TELNET_SERVER) + TELNETServerApp_Init(); + #endif +} + +/** uIP Management function. This function manages the uIP stack when called while an RNDIS device has been + * attached to the system. + */ +void uIPManagement_ManageNetwork(void) +{ + if (((USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Host) && (USB_HostState == HOST_STATE_Configured)) || + ((USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Device) && (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Configured))) + { + uIPManagement_ProcessIncomingPacket(); + uIPManagement_ManageConnections(); + } +} + +/** uIP TCP/IP network stack callback function for the processing of a given TCP connection. This routine dispatches + * to the appropriate TCP protocol application based on the connection's listen port number. + */ +void uIPManagement_TCPCallback(void) +{ + /* Call the correct TCP application based on the port number the connection is listening on */ + switch (uip_conn->lport) + { + case HTONS(HTTP_SERVER_PORT): + HTTPServerApp_Callback(); + break; + #if defined(ENABLE_TELNET_SERVER) + case HTONS(TELNET_SERVER_PORT): + TELNETServerApp_Callback(); + break; + #endif + } +} + +/** uIP TCP/IP network stack callback function for the processing of a given UDP connection. This routine dispatches + * to the appropriate UDP protocol application based on the connection's listen port number. + */ +void uIPManagement_UDPCallback(void) +{ + /* Call the correct UDP application based on the port number the connection is listening on */ + switch (uip_udp_conn->lport) + { + #if defined(ENABLE_DHCP_CLIENT) + case HTONS(DHCP_CLIENT_PORT): + DHCPClientApp_Callback(); + break; + #endif + #if defined(ENABLE_DHCP_SERVER) + case HTONS(DHCP_SERVER_PORT): + DHCPServerApp_Callback(); + break; + #endif + } +} + +/** Processes Incoming packets to the server from the connected RNDIS device, creating responses as needed. */ +static void uIPManagement_ProcessIncomingPacket(void) +{ + /* Determine which USB mode the system is currently initialized in */ + if (USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Device) + { + /* If no packet received, exit processing routine */ + if (!(RNDIS_Device_IsPacketReceived(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Device))) + return; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + + /* Read the Incoming packet straight into the UIP packet buffer */ + RNDIS_Device_ReadPacket(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Device, uip_buf, &uip_len); + } + else + { + /* If no packet received, exit processing routine */ + if (!(RNDIS_Host_IsPacketReceived(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Host))) + return; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + + /* Read the Incoming packet straight into the UIP packet buffer */ + RNDIS_Host_ReadPacket(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Host, uip_buf, &uip_len); + } + + /* If the packet contains an Ethernet frame, process it */ + if (uip_len > 0) + { + switch (((struct uip_eth_hdr*)uip_buf)->type) + { + case HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_IP): + /* Filter packet by MAC destination */ + uip_arp_ipin(); + + /* Process Incoming packet */ + uip_input(); + + /* If a response was generated, send it */ + if (uip_len > 0) + { + /* Add destination MAC to outgoing packet */ + uip_arp_out(); + + uip_split_output(); + } + + break; + case HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_ARP): + /* Process ARP packet */ + uip_arp_arpin(); + + /* If a response was generated, send it */ + if (uip_len > 0) + uip_split_output(); + + break; + } + } + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Manages the currently open network connections, including TCP and (if enabled) UDP. */ +static void uIPManagement_ManageConnections(void) +{ + /* Poll TCP connections for more data to send back to the host */ + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < UIP_CONNS; i++) + { + uip_poll_conn(&uip_conns[i]); + + /* If a response was generated, send it */ + if (uip_len > 0) + { + /* Add destination MAC to outgoing packet */ + uip_arp_out(); + + /* Split and send the outgoing packet */ + uip_split_output(); + } + } + + /* Manage open connections for timeouts */ + if (timer_expired(&ConnectionTimer)) + { + timer_reset(&ConnectionTimer); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < UIP_CONNS; i++) + { + /* Run periodic connection management for each TCP connection */ + uip_periodic(i); + + /* If a response was generated, send it */ + if (uip_len > 0) + { + /* Add destination MAC to outgoing packet */ + uip_arp_out(); + + /* Split and send the outgoing packet */ + uip_split_output(); + } + } + + #if defined(ENABLE_DHCP_CLIENT) + for (uint8_t i = 0; i < UIP_UDP_CONNS; i++) + { + /* Run periodic connection management for each UDP connection */ + uip_udp_periodic(i); + + /* If a response was generated, send it */ + if (uip_len > 0) + { + /* Add destination MAC to outgoing packet */ + uip_arp_out(); + + /* Split and send the outgoing packet */ + uip_split_output(); + } + } + #endif + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + } + + /* Manage ARP cache refreshing */ + if (timer_expired(&ARPTimer)) + { + timer_reset(&ARPTimer); + uip_arp_timer(); + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uIPManagement.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uIPManagement.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3bdc5c96b1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uIPManagement.h @@ -0,0 +1,69 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for uIPManagement.c. + */ + +#ifndef _UIP_MANAGEMENT_H_ +#define _UIP_MANAGEMENT_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include <uip.h> + #include <uip_arp.h> + #include <uip-split.h> + #include <timer.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include "DHCPClientApp.h" + #include "DHCPServerApp.h" + #include "HTTPServerApp.h" + #include "TELNETServerApp.h" + + /* External Variables: */ + extern struct uip_eth_addr MACAddress; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void uIPManagement_Init(void); + void uIPManagement_ManageNetwork(void); + void uIPManagement_TCPCallback(void); + void uIPManagement_UDPCallback(void); + + #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_UIPMANAGEMENT_C) + static void uIPManagement_ProcessIncomingPacket(void); + static void uIPManagement_ManageConnections(void); + #endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/clock.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/clock.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e71f7209d2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/clock.c @@ -0,0 +1,37 @@ +#include <stdint.h> +#include <stdlib.h> +#include <stdio.h> + +#include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + +#include "clock.h" + +//Counted time +volatile clock_time_t clock_datetime = 0; + +//Overflow interrupt +ISR(TIMER1_COMPA_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + clock_datetime += 1; +} + +//Initialise the clock +void clock_init() +{ + OCR1A = (((F_CPU / 1024) / 100) - 1); + TCCR1B = ((1 << WGM12) | (1 << CS12) | (1 << CS10)); + TIMSK1 = (1 << OCIE1A); +} + +//Return time +clock_time_t clock_time() +{ + clock_time_t time; + + GlobalInterruptDisable(); + time = clock_datetime; + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + return time; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/clock.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/clock.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bbfa4ac0e3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/clock.h @@ -0,0 +1,13 @@ +#ifndef __CLOCK_ARCH_H__ +#define __CLOCK_ARCH_H__ + +#include <stdint.h> +#include <util/atomic.h> + +typedef uint16_t clock_time_t; +#define CLOCK_SECOND 100 +void clock_init(void); +clock_time_t clock_time(void); + +#endif /* __CLOCK_ARCH_H__ */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/timer.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/timer.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..eae06f43bd --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/timer.c @@ -0,0 +1,128 @@ +/** + * \addtogroup timer + * @{ + */ + +/** + * \file + * Timer library implementation. + * \author + * Adam Dunkels <adam@sics.se> + */ + +/* + * Copyright (c) 2004, Swedish Institute of Computer Science. + * All rights reserved. + * + * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without + * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions + * are met: + * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright + * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. + * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright + * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the + * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. + * 3. Neither the name of the Institute nor the names of its contributors + * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software + * without specific prior written permission. + * + * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE INSTITUTE AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND + * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE + * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE + * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE INSTITUTE OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE + * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL + * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS + * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) + * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT + * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY + * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF + * SUCH DAMAGE. + * + * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack + * + * Author: Adam Dunkels <adam@sics.se> + * + * $Id: timer.c,v 1.2 2006/06/12 08:00:30 adam Exp $ + */ + +#include "clock.h" +#include "timer.h" + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * Set a timer. + * + * This function is used to set a timer for a time sometime in the + * future. The function timer_expired() will evaluate to true after + * the timer has expired. + * + * \param t A pointer to the timer + * \param interval The interval before the timer expires. + * + */ +void +timer_set(struct timer *t, clock_time_t interval) +{ + t->interval = interval; + t->start = clock_time(); +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * Reset the timer with the same interval. + * + * This function resets the timer with the same interval that was + * given to the timer_set() function. The start point of the interval + * is the exact time that the timer last expired. Therefore, this + * function will cause the timer to be stable over time, unlike the + * timer_restart() function. + * + * \param t A pointer to the timer. + * + * \sa timer_restart() + */ +void +timer_reset(struct timer *t) +{ + t->start += t->interval; +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * Restart the timer from the current point in time + * + * This function restarts a timer with the same interval that was + * given to the timer_set() function. The timer will start at the + * current time. + * + * \note A periodic timer will drift if this function is used to reset + * it. For periodic timers, use the timer_reset() function instead. + * + * \param t A pointer to the timer. + * + * \sa timer_reset() + */ +void +timer_restart(struct timer *t) +{ + t->start = clock_time(); +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * Check if a timer has expired. + * + * This function tests if a timer has expired and returns true or + * false depending on its status. + * + * \param t A pointer to the timer + * + * \return Non-zero if the timer has expired, zero otherwise. + * + */ +int +timer_expired(struct timer *t) +{ + return (clock_time_t)(clock_time() - t->start) >= (clock_time_t)t->interval; +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/timer.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/timer.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..04917e4c52 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/timer.h @@ -0,0 +1,87 @@ +/** + * \defgroup timer Timer library + * + * The timer library provides functions for setting, resetting and + * restarting timers, and for checking if a timer has expired. An + * application must "manually" check if its timers have expired; this + * is not done automatically. + * + * A timer is declared as a \c struct \c timer and all access to the + * timer is made by a pointer to the declared timer. + * + * \note The timer library uses the \ref clock "Clock library" to + * measure time. Intervals should be specified in the format used by + * the clock library. + * + * @{ + */ + + +/** + * \file + * Timer library header file. + * \author + * Adam Dunkels <adam@sics.se> + */ + +/* + * Copyright (c) 2004, Swedish Institute of Computer Science. + * All rights reserved. + * + * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without + * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions + * are met: + * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright + * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. + * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright + * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the + * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. + * 3. Neither the name of the Institute nor the names of its contributors + * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software + * without specific prior written permission. + * + * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE INSTITUTE AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND + * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE + * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE + * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE INSTITUTE OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE + * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL + * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS + * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) + * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT + * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY + * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF + * SUCH DAMAGE. + * + * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack + * + * Author: Adam Dunkels <adam@sics.se> + * + * $Id: timer.h,v 1.3 2006/06/11 21:46:39 adam Exp $ + */ +#ifndef __TIMER_H__ +#define __TIMER_H__ + +#include "clock.h" + +/** + * A timer. + * + * This structure is used for declaring a timer. The timer must be set + * with timer_set() before it can be used. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +struct timer { + clock_time_t start; + clock_time_t interval; +}; + +void timer_set(struct timer *t, clock_time_t interval); +void timer_reset(struct timer *t); +void timer_restart(struct timer *t); +int timer_expired(struct timer *t); + +#endif /* __TIMER_H__ */ + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip-split.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip-split.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5222a05b63 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip-split.c @@ -0,0 +1,151 @@ +/* + * Copyright (c) 2004, Swedish Institute of Computer Science. + * All rights reserved. + * + * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without + * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions + * are met: + * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright + * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. + * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright + * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the + * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. + * 3. Neither the name of the Institute nor the names of its contributors + * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software + * without specific prior written permission. + * + * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE INSTITUTE AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND + * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE + * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE + * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE INSTITUTE OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE + * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL + * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS + * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) + * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT + * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY + * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF + * SUCH DAMAGE. + * + * This file is part of the Contiki operating system. + * + * Author: Adam Dunkels <adam@sics.se> + * + * $Id: uip-split.c,v 1.2 2008/10/14 13:39:12 julienabeille Exp $ + */ + +#include "uip-split.h" + + +#define BUF ((struct uip_tcpip_hdr *)&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN]) + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_split_output(void) +{ +#if UIP_TCP + u16_t tcplen, len1, len2; + + /* We only try to split maximum sized TCP segments. */ + if(BUF->proto == UIP_PROTO_TCP && uip_len == UIP_BUFSIZE) { + + tcplen = uip_len - UIP_TCPIP_HLEN - UIP_LLH_LEN; + /* Split the segment in two. If the original packet length was + odd, we make the second packet one byte larger. */ + len1 = len2 = tcplen / 2; + if(len1 + len2 < tcplen) { + ++len2; + } + + /* Create the first packet. This is done by altering the length + field of the IP header and updating the checksums. */ + uip_len = len1 + UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN; +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 + /* For IPv6, the IP length field does not include the IPv6 IP header + length. */ + BUF->len[0] = ((uip_len - UIP_IPH_LEN) >> 8); + BUF->len[1] = ((uip_len - UIP_IPH_LEN) & 0xff); +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + BUF->len[0] = (uip_len - UIP_LLH_LEN) >> 8; + BUF->len[1] = (uip_len - UIP_LLH_LEN) & 0xff; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + + /* Recalculate the TCP checksum. */ + BUF->tcpchksum = 0; + BUF->tcpchksum = ~(uip_tcpchksum()); + +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 + /* Recalculate the IP checksum. */ + BUF->ipchksum = 0; + BUF->ipchksum = ~(uip_ipchksum()); +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + + /* Transmit the first packet. */ +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 + tcpip_ipv6_output(); +#else + if (USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Device) + RNDIS_Device_SendPacket(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Device, uip_buf, uip_len); + else + RNDIS_Host_SendPacket(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Host, uip_buf, uip_len); +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + + /* Now, create the second packet. To do this, it is not enough to + just alter the length field, but we must also update the TCP + sequence number and point the uip_appdata to a new place in + memory. This place is determined by the length of the first + packet (len1). */ + uip_len = len2 + UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN; +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 + /* For IPv6, the IP length field does not include the IPv6 IP header + length. */ + BUF->len[0] = ((uip_len - UIP_IPH_LEN) >> 8); + BUF->len[1] = ((uip_len - UIP_IPH_LEN) & 0xff); +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + BUF->len[0] = (uip_len - UIP_LLH_LEN) >> 8; + BUF->len[1] = (uip_len - UIP_LLH_LEN) & 0xff; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + + memcpy(uip_appdata, (u8_t *)uip_appdata + len1, len2); + + uip_add32(BUF->seqno, len1); + BUF->seqno[0] = uip_acc32[0]; + BUF->seqno[1] = uip_acc32[1]; + BUF->seqno[2] = uip_acc32[2]; + BUF->seqno[3] = uip_acc32[3]; + + /* Recalculate the TCP checksum. */ + BUF->tcpchksum = 0; + BUF->tcpchksum = ~(uip_tcpchksum()); + +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 + /* Recalculate the IP checksum. */ + BUF->ipchksum = 0; + BUF->ipchksum = ~(uip_ipchksum()); +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + + /* Transmit the second packet. */ +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 + tcpip_ipv6_output(); +#else + if (USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Device) + RNDIS_Device_SendPacket(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Device, uip_buf, uip_len); + else + RNDIS_Host_SendPacket(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Host, uip_buf, uip_len); +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + return; + } +#endif /* UIP_TCP */ + + /* uip_fw_output();*/ +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 + tcpip_ipv6_output(); +#else + if (USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Device) + RNDIS_Device_SendPacket(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Device, uip_buf, uip_len); + else + RNDIS_Host_SendPacket(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Host, uip_buf, uip_len); +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +} + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip-split.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip-split.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0c768ce40a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip-split.h @@ -0,0 +1,104 @@ +/* + * Copyright (c) 2004, Swedish Institute of Computer Science. + * All rights reserved. + * + * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without + * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions + * are met: + * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright + * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. + * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright + * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the + * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. + * 3. Neither the name of the Institute nor the names of its contributors + * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software + * without specific prior written permission. + * + * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE INSTITUTE AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND + * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE + * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE + * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE INSTITUTE OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE + * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL + * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS + * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) + * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT + * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY + * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF + * SUCH DAMAGE. + * + * This file is part of the Contiki operating system. + * + * Author: Adam Dunkels <adam@sics.se> + * + * $Id: uip-split.h,v 1.1 2006/06/17 22:41:19 adamdunkels Exp $ + */ +/** + * \addtogroup uip + * @{ + */ + +/** + * \defgroup uipsplit uIP TCP throughput booster hack + * @{ + * + * The basic uIP TCP implementation only allows each TCP connection to + * have a single TCP segment in flight at any given time. Because of + * the delayed ACK algorithm employed by most TCP receivers, uIP's + * limit on the amount of in-flight TCP segments seriously reduces the + * maximum achievable throughput for sending data from uIP. + * + * The uip-split module is a hack which tries to remedy this + * situation. By splitting maximum sized outgoing TCP segments into + * two, the delayed ACK algorithm is not invoked at TCP + * receivers. This improves the throughput when sending data from uIP + * by orders of magnitude. + * + * The uip-split module uses the uip-fw module (uIP IP packet + * forwarding) for sending packets. Therefore, the uip-fw module must + * be set up with the appropriate network interfaces for this module + * to work. + */ + + +/** + * \file + * Module for splitting outbound TCP segments in two to avoid the + * delayed ACK throughput degradation. + * \author + * Adam Dunkels <adam@sics.se> + * + */ + +#ifndef __UIP_SPLIT_H__ +#define __UIP_SPLIT_H__ + +#include <string.h> +#include <uip.h> + +#include "../../USBHostMode.h" + +#include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + +/** + * Handle outgoing packets. + * + * This function inspects an outgoing packet in the uip_buf buffer and + * sends it out using the uip_fw_output() function. If the packet is a + * full-sized TCP segment it will be split into two segments and + * transmitted separately. This function should be called instead of + * the actual device driver output function, or the uip_fw_output() + * function. + * + * The headers of the outgoing packet is assumed to be in the uip_buf + * buffer and the payload is assumed to be wherever uip_appdata + * points. The length of the outgoing packet is assumed to be in the + * uip_len variable. + * + */ +void uip_split_output(void); +void uip_add32(u8_t *op32, u16_t op16); +#endif /* __UIP_SPLIT_H__ */ + +/** @} */ +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fead75775c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip.c @@ -0,0 +1,1941 @@ +#define DEBUG_PRINTF(...) /*printf(__VA_ARGS__)*/ + +/** + * \addtogroup uip + * @{ + */ + +/** + * \file + * The uIP TCP/IP stack code. + * \author Adam Dunkels <adam@dunkels.com> + */ + +/* + * Copyright (c) 2001-2003, Adam Dunkels. + * All rights reserved. + * + * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without + * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions + * are met: + * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright + * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. + * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright + * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the + * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. + * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote + * products derived from this software without specific prior + * written permission. + * + * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS + * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED + * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE + * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY + * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL + * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE + * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS + * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, + * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING + * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS + * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. + * + * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. + * + * $Id: uip.c,v 1.15 2008/10/15 08:08:32 adamdunkels Exp $ + * + */ + +/* + * uIP is a small implementation of the IP, UDP and TCP protocols (as + * well as some basic ICMP stuff). The implementation couples the IP, + * UDP, TCP and the application layers very tightly. To keep the size + * of the compiled code down, this code frequently uses the goto + * statement. While it would be possible to break the uip_process() + * function into many smaller functions, this would increase the code + * size because of the overhead of parameter passing and the fact that + * the optimizer would not be as efficient. + * + * The principle is that we have a small buffer, called the uip_buf, + * in which the device driver puts an incoming packet. The TCP/IP + * stack parses the headers in the packet, and calls the + * application. If the remote host has sent data to the application, + * this data is present in the uip_buf and the application read the + * data from there. It is up to the application to put this data into + * a byte stream if needed. The application will not be fed with data + * that is out of sequence. + * + * If the application whishes to send data to the peer, it should put + * its data into the uip_buf. The uip_appdata pointer points to the + * first available byte. The TCP/IP stack will calculate the + * checksums, and fill in the necessary header fields and finally send + * the packet back to the peer. +*/ + +#include "uip.h" +#include "uipopt.h" +#include "uip_arp.h" + +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 /* If UIP_CONF_IPV6 is defined, we compile the + uip6.c file instead of this one. Therefore + this #ifndef removes the entire compilation + output of the uip.c file */ + + +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +#include "net/uip-neighbor.h" +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +#include <string.h> + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Variable definitions. */ + + +/* The IP address of this host. If it is defined to be fixed (by + setting UIP_FIXEDADDR to 1 in uipopt.h), the address is set + here. Otherwise, the address */ +#if UIP_FIXEDADDR > 0 +const uip_ipaddr_t uip_hostaddr = + { UIP_IPADDR0, UIP_IPADDR1, UIP_IPADDR2, UIP_IPADDR3 }; +const uip_ipaddr_t uip_draddr = + { UIP_DRIPADDR0, UIP_DRIPADDR1, UIP_DRIPADDR2, UIP_DRIPADDR3 }; +const uip_ipaddr_t uip_netmask = + { UIP_NETMASK0, UIP_NETMASK1, UIP_NETMASK2, UIP_NETMASK3 }; +#else +uip_ipaddr_t uip_hostaddr, uip_draddr, uip_netmask; +#endif /* UIP_FIXEDADDR */ + +const uip_ipaddr_t uip_broadcast_addr = +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 + { { 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, + 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff } }; +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + { { 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff } }; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +const uip_ipaddr_t uip_all_zeroes_addr = { { 0x0, /* rest is 0 */ } }; + +#if UIP_FIXEDETHADDR +const struct uip_eth_addr uip_ethaddr = {{UIP_ETHADDR0, + UIP_ETHADDR1, + UIP_ETHADDR2, + UIP_ETHADDR3, + UIP_ETHADDR4, + UIP_ETHADDR5}}; +#else +struct uip_eth_addr uip_ethaddr = {{0,0,0,0,0,0}}; +#endif + +#ifndef UIP_CONF_EXTERNAL_BUFFER +u8_t uip_buf[UIP_BUFSIZE + 2]; /* The packet buffer that contains + incoming packets. */ +#endif /* UIP_CONF_EXTERNAL_BUFFER */ + +void *uip_appdata; /* The uip_appdata pointer points to + application data. */ +void *uip_sappdata; /* The uip_appdata pointer points to + the application data which is to + be sent. */ +#if UIP_URGDATA > 0 +void *uip_urgdata; /* The uip_urgdata pointer points to + urgent data (out-of-band data), if + present. */ +u16_t uip_urglen, uip_surglen; +#endif /* UIP_URGDATA > 0 */ + +u16_t uip_len, uip_slen; + /* The uip_len is either 8 or 16 bits, + depending on the maximum packet + size. */ + +u8_t uip_flags; /* The uip_flags variable is used for + communication between the TCP/IP stack + and the application program. */ +struct uip_conn *uip_conn; /* uip_conn always points to the current + connection. */ + +struct uip_conn uip_conns[UIP_CONNS]; + /* The uip_conns array holds all TCP + connections. */ +u16_t uip_listenports[UIP_LISTENPORTS]; + /* The uip_listenports list all currently + listening ports. */ +#if UIP_UDP +struct uip_udp_conn *uip_udp_conn; +struct uip_udp_conn uip_udp_conns[UIP_UDP_CONNS]; +#endif /* UIP_UDP */ + +static u16_t ipid; /* Ths ipid variable is an increasing + number that is used for the IP ID + field. */ + +void uip_setipid(u16_t id) { ipid = id; } + +static u8_t iss[4]; /* The iss variable is used for the TCP + initial sequence number. */ + +#if UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN +static u16_t lastport; /* Keeps track of the last port used for + a new connection. */ +#endif /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ + +/* Temporary variables. */ +u8_t uip_acc32[4]; +static u8_t c, opt; +static u16_t tmp16; + +/* Structures and definitions. */ +#define TCP_FIN 0x01 +#define TCP_SYN 0x02 +#define TCP_RST 0x04 +#define TCP_PSH 0x08 +#define TCP_ACK 0x10 +#define TCP_URG 0x20 +#define TCP_CTL 0x3f + +#define TCP_OPT_END 0 /* End of TCP options list */ +#define TCP_OPT_NOOP 1 /* "No-operation" TCP option */ +#define TCP_OPT_MSS 2 /* Maximum segment size TCP option */ + +#define TCP_OPT_MSS_LEN 4 /* Length of TCP MSS option. */ + +#define ICMP_ECHO_REPLY 0 +#define ICMP_ECHO 8 + +#define ICMP_DEST_UNREACHABLE 3 +#define ICMP_PORT_UNREACHABLE 3 + +#define ICMP6_ECHO_REPLY 129 +#define ICMP6_ECHO 128 +#define ICMP6_NEIGHBOR_SOLICITATION 135 +#define ICMP6_NEIGHBOR_ADVERTISEMENT 136 + +#define ICMP6_FLAG_S (1 << 6) + +#define ICMP6_OPTION_SOURCE_LINK_ADDRESS 1 +#define ICMP6_OPTION_TARGET_LINK_ADDRESS 2 + + +/* Macros. */ +#define BUF ((struct uip_tcpip_hdr *)&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN]) +#define FBUF ((struct uip_tcpip_hdr *)&uip_reassbuf[0]) +#define ICMPBUF ((struct uip_icmpip_hdr *)&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN]) +#define UDPBUF ((struct uip_udpip_hdr *)&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN]) + + +#if UIP_STATISTICS == 1 +struct uip_stats uip_stat; +#define UIP_STAT(s) s +#else +#define UIP_STAT(s) +#endif /* UIP_STATISTICS == 1 */ + +#if UIP_LOGGING == 1 +#include <stdio.h> +void uip_log(char *msg); +#define UIP_LOG(m) uip_log(m) +#else +#define UIP_LOG(m) +#endif /* UIP_LOGGING == 1 */ + +#if ! UIP_ARCH_ADD32 +void +uip_add32(u8_t *op32, u16_t op16) +{ + uip_acc32[3] = op32[3] + (op16 & 0xff); + uip_acc32[2] = op32[2] + (op16 >> 8); + uip_acc32[1] = op32[1]; + uip_acc32[0] = op32[0]; + + if(uip_acc32[2] < (op16 >> 8)) { + ++uip_acc32[1]; + if(uip_acc32[1] == 0) { + ++uip_acc32[0]; + } + } + + + if(uip_acc32[3] < (op16 & 0xff)) { + ++uip_acc32[2]; + if(uip_acc32[2] == 0) { + ++uip_acc32[1]; + if(uip_acc32[1] == 0) { + ++uip_acc32[0]; + } + } + } +} + +#endif /* UIP_ARCH_ADD32 */ + +#if ! UIP_ARCH_CHKSUM +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +static u16_t +chksum(u16_t sum, const u8_t *data, u16_t len) +{ + u16_t t; + const u8_t *dataptr; + const u8_t *last_byte; + + dataptr = data; + last_byte = data + len - 1; + + while(dataptr < last_byte) { /* At least two more bytes */ + t = (dataptr[0] << 8) + dataptr[1]; + sum += t; + if(sum < t) { + sum++; /* carry */ + } + dataptr += 2; + } + + if(dataptr == last_byte) { + t = (dataptr[0] << 8) + 0; + sum += t; + if(sum < t) { + sum++; /* carry */ + } + } + + /* Return sum in host byte order. */ + return sum; +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +u16_t +uip_chksum(u16_t *data, u16_t len) +{ + return htons(chksum(0, (u8_t *)data, len)); +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#ifndef UIP_ARCH_IPCHKSUM +u16_t +uip_ipchksum(void) +{ + u16_t sum; + + sum = chksum(0, &uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN], UIP_IPH_LEN); + DEBUG_PRINTF("uip_ipchksum: sum 0x%04x\n", sum); + return (sum == 0) ? 0xffff : htons(sum); +} +#endif +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +static u16_t +upper_layer_chksum(u8_t proto) +{ + u16_t upper_layer_len; + u16_t sum; + +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 + upper_layer_len = (((u16_t)(BUF->len[0]) << 8) + BUF->len[1]); +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + upper_layer_len = (((u16_t)(BUF->len[0]) << 8) + BUF->len[1]) - UIP_IPH_LEN; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + + /* First sum pseudo-header. */ + + /* IP protocol and length fields. This addition cannot carry. */ + sum = upper_layer_len + proto; + /* Sum IP source and destination addresses. */ + sum = chksum(sum, (u8_t *)&BUF->srcipaddr, 2 * sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); + + /* Sum TCP header and data. */ + sum = chksum(sum, &uip_buf[UIP_IPH_LEN + UIP_LLH_LEN], + upper_layer_len); + + return (sum == 0) ? 0xffff : htons(sum); +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +u16_t +uip_icmp6chksum(void) +{ + return upper_layer_chksum(UIP_PROTO_ICMP6); + +} +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +u16_t +uip_tcpchksum(void) +{ + return upper_layer_chksum(UIP_PROTO_TCP); +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS +u16_t +uip_udpchksum(void) +{ + return upper_layer_chksum(UIP_PROTO_UDP); +} +#endif /* UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS */ +#endif /* UIP_ARCH_CHKSUM */ +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_init(void) +{ + for(c = 0; c < UIP_LISTENPORTS; ++c) { + uip_listenports[c] = 0; + } + for(c = 0; c < UIP_CONNS; ++c) { + uip_conns[c].tcpstateflags = UIP_CLOSED; + } +#if UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN + lastport = 1024; +#endif /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ + +#if UIP_UDP + for(c = 0; c < UIP_UDP_CONNS; ++c) { + uip_udp_conns[c].lport = 0; + } +#endif /* UIP_UDP */ + + + /* IPv4 initialization. */ +#if UIP_FIXEDADDR == 0 + /* uip_hostaddr[0] = uip_hostaddr[1] = 0;*/ +#endif /* UIP_FIXEDADDR */ + +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN +struct uip_conn * +uip_connect(uip_ipaddr_t *ripaddr, u16_t rport) +{ + register struct uip_conn *conn, *cconn; + + /* Find an unused local port. */ + again: + ++lastport; + + if(lastport >= 32000) { + lastport = 4096; + } + + /* Check if this port is already in use, and if so try to find + another one. */ + for(c = 0; c < UIP_CONNS; ++c) { + conn = &uip_conns[c]; + if(conn->tcpstateflags != UIP_CLOSED && + conn->lport == htons(lastport)) { + goto again; + } + } + + conn = 0; + for(c = 0; c < UIP_CONNS; ++c) { + cconn = &uip_conns[c]; + if(cconn->tcpstateflags == UIP_CLOSED) { + conn = cconn; + break; + } + if(cconn->tcpstateflags == UIP_TIME_WAIT) { + if(conn == 0 || + cconn->timer > conn->timer) { + conn = cconn; + } + } + } + + if(conn == 0) { + return 0; + } + + conn->tcpstateflags = UIP_SYN_SENT; + + conn->snd_nxt[0] = iss[0]; + conn->snd_nxt[1] = iss[1]; + conn->snd_nxt[2] = iss[2]; + conn->snd_nxt[3] = iss[3]; + + conn->initialmss = conn->mss = UIP_TCP_MSS; + + conn->len = 1; /* TCP length of the SYN is one. */ + conn->nrtx = 0; + conn->timer = 1; /* Send the SYN next time around. */ + conn->rto = UIP_RTO; + conn->sa = 0; + conn->sv = 16; /* Initial value of the RTT variance. */ + conn->lport = htons(lastport); + conn->rport = rport; + uip_ipaddr_copy(&conn->ripaddr, ripaddr); + + return conn; +} +#endif /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if UIP_UDP +struct uip_udp_conn * +uip_udp_new(const uip_ipaddr_t *ripaddr, u16_t rport) +{ + register struct uip_udp_conn *conn; + + /* Find an unused local port. */ + again: + ++lastport; + + if(lastport >= 32000) { + lastport = 4096; + } + + for(c = 0; c < UIP_UDP_CONNS; ++c) { + if(uip_udp_conns[c].lport == htons(lastport)) { + goto again; + } + } + + + conn = 0; + for(c = 0; c < UIP_UDP_CONNS; ++c) { + if(uip_udp_conns[c].lport == 0) { + conn = &uip_udp_conns[c]; + break; + } + } + + if(conn == 0) { + return 0; + } + + conn->lport = HTONS(lastport); + conn->rport = rport; + if(ripaddr == NULL) { + memset(&conn->ripaddr, 0, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); + } else { + uip_ipaddr_copy(&conn->ripaddr, ripaddr); + } + conn->ttl = UIP_TTL; + + return conn; +} +#endif /* UIP_UDP */ +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_unlisten(u16_t port) +{ + for(c = 0; c < UIP_LISTENPORTS; ++c) { + if(uip_listenports[c] == port) { + uip_listenports[c] = 0; + return; + } + } +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_listen(u16_t port) +{ + for(c = 0; c < UIP_LISTENPORTS; ++c) { + if(uip_listenports[c] == 0) { + uip_listenports[c] = port; + return; + } + } +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* XXX: IP fragment reassembly: not well-tested. */ + +#if UIP_REASSEMBLY && !UIP_CONF_IPV6 +#define UIP_REASS_BUFSIZE (UIP_BUFSIZE - UIP_LLH_LEN) +static u8_t uip_reassbuf[UIP_REASS_BUFSIZE]; +static u8_t uip_reassbitmap[UIP_REASS_BUFSIZE / (8 * 8)]; +static const u8_t bitmap_bits[8] = {0xff, 0x7f, 0x3f, 0x1f, + 0x0f, 0x07, 0x03, 0x01}; +static u16_t uip_reasslen; +static u8_t uip_reassflags; +#define UIP_REASS_FLAG_LASTFRAG 0x01 +static u8_t uip_reasstmr; + +#define IP_MF 0x20 + +static u8_t +uip_reass(void) +{ + u16_t offset, len; + u16_t i; + + /* If ip_reasstmr is zero, no packet is present in the buffer, so we + write the IP header of the fragment into the reassembly + buffer. The timer is updated with the maximum age. */ + if(uip_reasstmr == 0) { + memcpy(uip_reassbuf, &BUF->vhl, UIP_IPH_LEN); + uip_reasstmr = UIP_REASS_MAXAGE; + uip_reassflags = 0; + /* Clear the bitmap. */ + memset(uip_reassbitmap, 0, sizeof(uip_reassbitmap)); + } + + /* Check if the incoming fragment matches the one currently present + in the reasembly buffer. If so, we proceed with copying the + fragment into the buffer. */ + if(BUF->srcipaddr[0] == FBUF->srcipaddr[0] && + BUF->srcipaddr[1] == FBUF->srcipaddr[1] && + BUF->destipaddr[0] == FBUF->destipaddr[0] && + BUF->destipaddr[1] == FBUF->destipaddr[1] && + BUF->ipid[0] == FBUF->ipid[0] && + BUF->ipid[1] == FBUF->ipid[1]) { + + len = (BUF->len[0] << 8) + BUF->len[1] - (BUF->vhl & 0x0f) * 4; + offset = (((BUF->ipoffset[0] & 0x3f) << 8) + BUF->ipoffset[1]) * 8; + + /* If the offset or the offset + fragment length overflows the + reassembly buffer, we discard the entire packet. */ + if(offset > UIP_REASS_BUFSIZE || + offset + len > UIP_REASS_BUFSIZE) { + uip_reasstmr = 0; + goto nullreturn; + } + + /* Copy the fragment into the reassembly buffer, at the right + offset. */ + memcpy(&uip_reassbuf[UIP_IPH_LEN + offset], + (char *)BUF + (int)((BUF->vhl & 0x0f) * 4), + len); + + /* Update the bitmap. */ + if(offset / (8 * 8) == (offset + len) / (8 * 8)) { + /* If the two endpoints are in the same byte, we only update + that byte. */ + + uip_reassbitmap[offset / (8 * 8)] |= + bitmap_bits[(offset / 8 ) & 7] & + ~bitmap_bits[((offset + len) / 8 ) & 7]; + } else { + /* If the two endpoints are in different bytes, we update the + bytes in the endpoints and fill the stuff in-between with + 0xff. */ + uip_reassbitmap[offset / (8 * 8)] |= + bitmap_bits[(offset / 8 ) & 7]; + for(i = 1 + offset / (8 * 8); i < (offset + len) / (8 * 8); ++i) { + uip_reassbitmap[i] = 0xff; + } + uip_reassbitmap[(offset + len) / (8 * 8)] |= + ~bitmap_bits[((offset + len) / 8 ) & 7]; + } + + /* If this fragment has the More Fragments flag set to zero, we + know that this is the last fragment, so we can calculate the + size of the entire packet. We also set the + IP_REASS_FLAG_LASTFRAG flag to indicate that we have received + the final fragment. */ + + if((BUF->ipoffset[0] & IP_MF) == 0) { + uip_reassflags |= UIP_REASS_FLAG_LASTFRAG; + uip_reasslen = offset + len; + } + + /* Finally, we check if we have a full packet in the buffer. We do + this by checking if we have the last fragment and if all bits + in the bitmap are set. */ + if(uip_reassflags & UIP_REASS_FLAG_LASTFRAG) { + /* Check all bytes up to and including all but the last byte in + the bitmap. */ + for(i = 0; i < uip_reasslen / (8 * 8) - 1; ++i) { + if(uip_reassbitmap[i] != 0xff) { + goto nullreturn; + } + } + /* Check the last byte in the bitmap. It should contain just the + right amount of bits. */ + if(uip_reassbitmap[uip_reasslen / (8 * 8)] != + (u8_t)~bitmap_bits[uip_reasslen / 8 & 7]) { + goto nullreturn; + } + + /* If we have come this far, we have a full packet in the + buffer, so we allocate a pbuf and copy the packet into it. We + also reset the timer. */ + uip_reasstmr = 0; + memcpy(BUF, FBUF, uip_reasslen); + + /* Pretend to be a "normal" (i.e., not fragmented) IP packet + from now on. */ + BUF->ipoffset[0] = BUF->ipoffset[1] = 0; + BUF->len[0] = uip_reasslen >> 8; + BUF->len[1] = uip_reasslen & 0xff; + BUF->ipchksum = 0; + BUF->ipchksum = ~(uip_ipchksum()); + + return uip_reasslen; + } + } + + nullreturn: + return 0; +} +#endif /* UIP_REASSEMBLY */ +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +static void +uip_add_rcv_nxt(u16_t n) +{ + uip_add32(uip_conn->rcv_nxt, n); + uip_conn->rcv_nxt[0] = uip_acc32[0]; + uip_conn->rcv_nxt[1] = uip_acc32[1]; + uip_conn->rcv_nxt[2] = uip_acc32[2]; + uip_conn->rcv_nxt[3] = uip_acc32[3]; +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_process(u8_t flag) +{ + register struct uip_conn *uip_connr = uip_conn; + +#if UIP_UDP + if(flag == UIP_UDP_SEND_CONN) { + goto udp_send; + } +#endif /* UIP_UDP */ + + uip_sappdata = uip_appdata = &uip_buf[UIP_IPTCPH_LEN + UIP_LLH_LEN]; + + /* Check if we were invoked because of a poll request for a + particular connection. */ + if(flag == UIP_POLL_REQUEST) { + if((uip_connr->tcpstateflags & UIP_TS_MASK) == UIP_ESTABLISHED && + !uip_outstanding(uip_connr)) { + uip_len = uip_slen = 0; + uip_flags = UIP_POLL; + UIP_APPCALL(); + goto appsend; + } + goto drop; + + /* Check if we were invoked because of the periodic timer firing. */ + } else if(flag == UIP_TIMER) { +#if UIP_REASSEMBLY + if(uip_reasstmr != 0) { + --uip_reasstmr; + } +#endif /* UIP_REASSEMBLY */ + /* Increase the initial sequence number. */ + if(++iss[3] == 0) { + if(++iss[2] == 0) { + if(++iss[1] == 0) { + ++iss[0]; + } + } + } + + /* Reset the length variables. */ + uip_len = 0; + uip_slen = 0; + + /* Check if the connection is in a state in which we simply wait + for the connection to time out. If so, we increase the + connection's timer and remove the connection if it times + out. */ + if(uip_connr->tcpstateflags == UIP_TIME_WAIT || + uip_connr->tcpstateflags == UIP_FIN_WAIT_2) { + ++(uip_connr->timer); + if(uip_connr->timer == UIP_TIME_WAIT_TIMEOUT) { + uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_CLOSED; + } + } else if(uip_connr->tcpstateflags != UIP_CLOSED) { + /* If the connection has outstanding data, we increase the + connection's timer and see if it has reached the RTO value + in which case we retransmit. */ + if(uip_outstanding(uip_connr)) { + if(uip_connr->timer-- == 0) { + if(uip_connr->nrtx == UIP_MAXRTX || + ((uip_connr->tcpstateflags == UIP_SYN_SENT || + uip_connr->tcpstateflags == UIP_SYN_RCVD) && + uip_connr->nrtx == UIP_MAXSYNRTX)) { + uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_CLOSED; + + /* We call UIP_APPCALL() with uip_flags set to + UIP_TIMEDOUT to inform the application that the + connection has timed out. */ + uip_flags = UIP_TIMEDOUT; + UIP_APPCALL(); + + /* We also send a reset packet to the remote host. */ + BUF->flags = TCP_RST | TCP_ACK; + goto tcp_send_nodata; + } + + /* Exponential back-off. */ + uip_connr->timer = UIP_RTO << (uip_connr->nrtx > 4? + 4: + uip_connr->nrtx); + ++(uip_connr->nrtx); + + /* Ok, so we need to retransmit. We do this differently + depending on which state we are in. In ESTABLISHED, we + call upon the application so that it may prepare the + data for the retransmit. In SYN_RCVD, we resend the + SYNACK that we sent earlier and in LAST_ACK we have to + retransmit our FINACK. */ + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.rexmit); + switch(uip_connr->tcpstateflags & UIP_TS_MASK) { + case UIP_SYN_RCVD: + /* In the SYN_RCVD state, we should retransmit our + SYNACK. */ + goto tcp_send_synack; + +#if UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN + case UIP_SYN_SENT: + /* In the SYN_SENT state, we retransmit out SYN. */ + BUF->flags = 0; + goto tcp_send_syn; +#endif /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ + + case UIP_ESTABLISHED: + /* In the ESTABLISHED state, we call upon the application + to do the actual retransmit after which we jump into + the code for sending out the packet (the apprexmit + label). */ + uip_flags = UIP_REXMIT; + UIP_APPCALL(); + goto apprexmit; + + case UIP_FIN_WAIT_1: + case UIP_CLOSING: + case UIP_LAST_ACK: + /* In all these states we should retransmit a FINACK. */ + goto tcp_send_finack; + + } + } + } else if((uip_connr->tcpstateflags & UIP_TS_MASK) == UIP_ESTABLISHED) { + /* If there was no need for a retransmission, we poll the + application for new data. */ + uip_len = uip_slen = 0; + uip_flags = UIP_POLL; + UIP_APPCALL(); + goto appsend; + } + } + goto drop; + } +#if UIP_UDP + if(flag == UIP_UDP_TIMER) { + if(uip_udp_conn->lport != 0) { + uip_conn = NULL; + uip_sappdata = uip_appdata = &uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_IPUDPH_LEN]; + uip_len = uip_slen = 0; + uip_flags = UIP_POLL; + UIP_UDP_APPCALL(); + goto udp_send; + } else { + goto drop; + } + } +#endif + + /* This is where the input processing starts. */ + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.recv); + + /* Start of IP input header processing code. */ + +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 + /* Check validity of the IP header. */ + if((BUF->vtc & 0xf0) != 0x60) { /* IP version and header length. */ + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.vhlerr); + UIP_LOG("ipv6: invalid version."); + goto drop; + } +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + /* Check validity of the IP header. */ + if(BUF->vhl != 0x45) { /* IP version and header length. */ + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.vhlerr); + UIP_LOG("ip: invalid version or header length."); + goto drop; + } +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + + /* Check the size of the packet. If the size reported to us in + uip_len is smaller the size reported in the IP header, we assume + that the packet has been corrupted in transit. If the size of + uip_len is larger than the size reported in the IP packet header, + the packet has been padded and we set uip_len to the correct + value.. */ + + if((BUF->len[0] << 8) + BUF->len[1] <= uip_len) { + uip_len = (BUF->len[0] << 8) + BUF->len[1]; +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 + uip_len += 40; /* The length reported in the IPv6 header is the + length of the payload that follows the + header. However, uIP uses the uip_len variable + for holding the size of the entire packet, + including the IP header. For IPv4 this is not a + problem as the length field in the IPv4 header + contains the length of the entire packet. But + for IPv6 we need to add the size of the IPv6 + header (40 bytes). */ +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + } else { + UIP_LOG("ip: packet shorter than reported in IP header."); + goto drop; + } + +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 + /* Check the fragment flag. */ + if((BUF->ipoffset[0] & 0x3f) != 0 || + BUF->ipoffset[1] != 0) { +#if UIP_REASSEMBLY + uip_len = uip_reass(); + if(uip_len == 0) { + goto drop; + } +#else /* UIP_REASSEMBLY */ + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.fragerr); + UIP_LOG("ip: fragment dropped."); + goto drop; +#endif /* UIP_REASSEMBLY */ + } +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + + if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&uip_hostaddr, &uip_all_zeroes_addr)) { + /* If we are configured to use ping IP address configuration and + hasn't been assigned an IP address yet, we accept all ICMP + packets. */ +#if UIP_PINGADDRCONF && !UIP_CONF_IPV6 + if(BUF->proto == UIP_PROTO_ICMP) { + UIP_LOG("ip: possible ping config packet received."); + goto icmp_input; + } else { + UIP_LOG("ip: packet dropped since no address assigned."); + goto drop; + } +#endif /* UIP_PINGADDRCONF */ + + } else { + /* If IP broadcast support is configured, we check for a broadcast + UDP packet, which may be destined to us. */ +#if UIP_BROADCAST + DEBUG_PRINTF("UDP IP checksum 0x%04x\n", uip_ipchksum()); + if(BUF->proto == UIP_PROTO_UDP && + uip_ipaddr_cmp(&BUF->destipaddr, &uip_broadcast_addr)) + { + if (uip_ipaddr_cmp(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_all_zeroes_addr)) + uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_broadcast_addr); + + goto udp_input; + } +#endif /* UIP_BROADCAST */ + + /* Check if the packet is destined for our IP address. */ +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 + if(!uip_ipaddr_cmp(&BUF->destipaddr, &uip_hostaddr)) { + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); + goto drop; + } +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + /* For IPv6, packet reception is a little trickier as we need to + make sure that we listen to certain multicast addresses (all + hosts multicast address, and the solicited-node multicast + address) as well. However, we will cheat here and accept all + multicast packets that are sent to the ff02::/16 addresses. */ + if(!uip_ipaddr_cmp(&BUF->destipaddr, &uip_hostaddr) && + BUF->destipaddr.u16[0] != HTONS(0xff02)) { + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); + goto drop; + } +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + } + +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 + if(uip_ipchksum() != 0xffff) { /* Compute and check the IP header + checksum. */ + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.chkerr); + UIP_LOG("ip: bad checksum."); + goto drop; + } +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + + if(BUF->proto == UIP_PROTO_TCP) { /* Check for TCP packet. If so, + proceed with TCP input + processing. */ + goto tcp_input; + } + +#if UIP_UDP + if(BUF->proto == UIP_PROTO_UDP) { + goto udp_input; + } +#endif /* UIP_UDP */ + +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 + /* ICMPv4 processing code follows. */ + if(BUF->proto != UIP_PROTO_ICMP) { /* We only allow ICMP packets from + here. */ + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.protoerr); + UIP_LOG("ip: neither tcp nor icmp."); + goto drop; + } + +#if UIP_PINGADDRCONF + icmp_input: +#endif /* UIP_PINGADDRCONF */ + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.recv); + + /* ICMP echo (i.e., ping) processing. This is simple, we only change + the ICMP type from ECHO to ECHO_REPLY and adjust the ICMP + checksum before we return the packet. */ + if(ICMPBUF->type != ICMP_ECHO) { + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.drop); + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.typeerr); + UIP_LOG("icmp: not icmp echo."); + goto drop; + } + + /* If we are configured to use ping IP address assignment, we use + the destination IP address of this ping packet and assign it to + yourself. */ +#if UIP_PINGADDRCONF + if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&uip_hostaddr, &uip_all_zeroes_addr)) { + uip_hostaddr = BUF->destipaddr; + } +#endif /* UIP_PINGADDRCONF */ + + ICMPBUF->type = ICMP_ECHO_REPLY; + + if(ICMPBUF->icmpchksum >= HTONS(0xffff - (ICMP_ECHO << 8))) { + ICMPBUF->icmpchksum += HTONS(ICMP_ECHO << 8) + 1; + } else { + ICMPBUF->icmpchksum += HTONS(ICMP_ECHO << 8); + } + + /* Swap IP addresses. */ + uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->destipaddr, &BUF->srcipaddr); + uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_hostaddr); + + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.sent); + BUF->ttl = UIP_TTL; + goto ip_send_nolen; + + /* End of IPv4 input header processing code. */ +#else /* !UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + + /* This is IPv6 ICMPv6 processing code. */ + DEBUG_PRINTF("icmp6_input: length %d\n", uip_len); + + if(BUF->proto != UIP_PROTO_ICMP6) { /* We only allow ICMPv6 packets from + here. */ + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.protoerr); + UIP_LOG("ip: neither tcp nor icmp6."); + goto drop; + } + + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.recv); + + /* If we get a neighbor solicitation for our address we should send + a neighbor advertisement message back. */ + if(ICMPBUF->type == ICMP6_NEIGHBOR_SOLICITATION) { + if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&ICMPBUF->icmp6data, &uip_hostaddr)) { + + if(ICMPBUF->options[0] == ICMP6_OPTION_SOURCE_LINK_ADDRESS) { + /* Save the sender's address in our neighbor list. */ + uip_neighbor_add(&ICMPBUF->srcipaddr, &(ICMPBUF->options[2])); + } + + /* We should now send a neighbor advertisement back to where the + neighbor solicitation came from. */ + ICMPBUF->type = ICMP6_NEIGHBOR_ADVERTISEMENT; + ICMPBUF->flags = ICMP6_FLAG_S; /* Solicited flag. */ + + ICMPBUF->reserved1 = ICMPBUF->reserved2 = ICMPBUF->reserved3 = 0; + + uip_ipaddr_copy(&ICMPBUF->destipaddr, &ICMPBUF->srcipaddr); + uip_ipaddr_copy(&ICMPBUF->srcipaddr, &uip_hostaddr); + ICMPBUF->options[0] = ICMP6_OPTION_TARGET_LINK_ADDRESS; + ICMPBUF->options[1] = 1; /* Options length, 1 = 8 bytes. */ + memcpy(&(ICMPBUF->options[2]), &uip_ethaddr, sizeof(uip_ethaddr)); + ICMPBUF->icmpchksum = 0; + ICMPBUF->icmpchksum = ~uip_icmp6chksum(); + + goto send; + + } + goto drop; + } else if(ICMPBUF->type == ICMP6_ECHO) { + /* ICMP echo (i.e., ping) processing. This is simple, we only + change the ICMP type from ECHO to ECHO_REPLY and update the + ICMP checksum before we return the packet. */ + + ICMPBUF->type = ICMP6_ECHO_REPLY; + + uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->destipaddr, &BUF->srcipaddr); + uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_hostaddr); + ICMPBUF->icmpchksum = 0; + ICMPBUF->icmpchksum = ~uip_icmp6chksum(); + + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.sent); + goto send; + } else { + DEBUG_PRINTF("Unknown icmp6 message type %d\n", ICMPBUF->type); + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.drop); + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.typeerr); + UIP_LOG("icmp: unknown ICMP message."); + goto drop; + } + + /* End of IPv6 ICMP processing. */ + +#endif /* !UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +#if UIP_UDP + /* UDP input processing. */ + udp_input: + /* UDP processing is really just a hack. We don't do anything to the + UDP/IP headers, but let the UDP application do all the hard + work. If the application sets uip_slen, it has a packet to + send. */ +#if UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS + uip_len = uip_len - UIP_IPUDPH_LEN; + uip_appdata = &uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_IPUDPH_LEN]; + if(UDPBUF->udpchksum != 0 && uip_udpchksum() != 0xffff) { + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.udp.drop); + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.udp.chkerr); + UIP_LOG("udp: bad checksum."); + goto drop; + } +#else /* UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS */ + uip_len = uip_len - UIP_IPUDPH_LEN; +#endif /* UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS */ + + /* Demultiplex this UDP packet between the UDP "connections". */ + for(uip_udp_conn = &uip_udp_conns[0]; + uip_udp_conn < &uip_udp_conns[UIP_UDP_CONNS]; + ++uip_udp_conn) { + /* If the local UDP port is non-zero, the connection is considered + to be used. If so, the local port number is checked against the + destination port number in the received packet. If the two port + numbers match, the remote port number is checked if the + connection is bound to a remote port. Finally, if the + connection is bound to a remote IP address, the source IP + address of the packet is checked. */ + if(uip_udp_conn->lport != 0 && + UDPBUF->destport == uip_udp_conn->lport && + (uip_udp_conn->rport == 0 || + UDPBUF->srcport == uip_udp_conn->rport) && + (uip_ipaddr_cmp(&uip_udp_conn->ripaddr, &uip_all_zeroes_addr) || + uip_ipaddr_cmp(&uip_udp_conn->ripaddr, &uip_broadcast_addr) || + uip_ipaddr_cmp(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_udp_conn->ripaddr))) { + goto udp_found; + } + } + UIP_LOG("udp: no matching connection found"); +#if UIP_CONF_ICMP_DEST_UNREACH && !UIP_CONF_IPV6 + /* Copy fields from packet header into payload of this ICMP packet. */ + memcpy(&(ICMPBUF->payload[0]), ICMPBUF, UIP_IPH_LEN + 8); + + /* Set the ICMP type and code. */ + ICMPBUF->type = ICMP_DEST_UNREACHABLE; + ICMPBUF->icode = ICMP_PORT_UNREACHABLE; + + /* Calculate the ICMP checksum. */ + ICMPBUF->icmpchksum = 0; + ICMPBUF->icmpchksum = ~uip_chksum((u16_t *)&(ICMPBUF->type), 36); + + /* Set the IP destination address to be the source address of the + original packet. */ + uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->destipaddr, &BUF->srcipaddr); + + /* Set our IP address as the source address. */ + uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_hostaddr); + + /* The size of the ICMP destination unreachable packet is 36 + the + size of the IP header (20) = 56. */ + uip_len = 36 + UIP_IPH_LEN; + ICMPBUF->len[0] = 0; + ICMPBUF->len[1] = (u8_t)uip_len; + ICMPBUF->ttl = UIP_TTL; + ICMPBUF->proto = UIP_PROTO_ICMP; + + goto ip_send_nolen; +#else /* UIP_CONF_ICMP_DEST_UNREACH */ + goto drop; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_ICMP_DEST_UNREACH */ + + udp_found: + uip_conn = NULL; + uip_flags = UIP_NEWDATA; + uip_sappdata = uip_appdata = &uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_IPUDPH_LEN]; + uip_slen = 0; + UIP_UDP_APPCALL(); + + udp_send: + if(uip_slen == 0) { + goto drop; + } + uip_len = uip_slen + UIP_IPUDPH_LEN; + +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 + /* For IPv6, the IP length field does not include the IPv6 IP header + length. */ + BUF->len[0] = ((uip_len - UIP_IPH_LEN) >> 8); + BUF->len[1] = ((uip_len - UIP_IPH_LEN) & 0xff); +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + BUF->len[0] = (uip_len >> 8); + BUF->len[1] = (uip_len & 0xff); +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + + BUF->ttl = uip_udp_conn->ttl; + BUF->proto = UIP_PROTO_UDP; + + UDPBUF->udplen = HTONS(uip_slen + UIP_UDPH_LEN); + UDPBUF->udpchksum = 0; + + BUF->srcport = uip_udp_conn->lport; + BUF->destport = uip_udp_conn->rport; + + uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_hostaddr); + uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->destipaddr, &uip_udp_conn->ripaddr); + + uip_appdata = &uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_IPTCPH_LEN]; + +#if UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS + /* Calculate UDP checksum. */ + UDPBUF->udpchksum = ~(uip_udpchksum()); + if(UDPBUF->udpchksum == 0) { + UDPBUF->udpchksum = 0xffff; + } +#endif /* UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS */ + + goto ip_send_nolen; +#endif /* UIP_UDP */ + + /* TCP input processing. */ + tcp_input: + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.recv); + + /* Start of TCP input header processing code. */ + + if(uip_tcpchksum() != 0xffff) { /* Compute and check the TCP + checksum. */ + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.drop); + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.chkerr); + UIP_LOG("tcp: bad checksum."); + goto drop; + } + + /* Demultiplex this segment. */ + /* First check any active connections. */ + for(uip_connr = &uip_conns[0]; uip_connr <= &uip_conns[UIP_CONNS - 1]; + ++uip_connr) { + if(uip_connr->tcpstateflags != UIP_CLOSED && + BUF->destport == uip_connr->lport && + BUF->srcport == uip_connr->rport && + uip_ipaddr_cmp(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_connr->ripaddr)) { + goto found; + } + } + + /* If we didn't find and active connection that expected the packet, + either this packet is an old duplicate, or this is a SYN packet + destined for a connection in LISTEN. If the SYN flag isn't set, + it is an old packet and we send a RST. */ + if((BUF->flags & TCP_CTL) != TCP_SYN) { + goto reset; + } + + tmp16 = BUF->destport; + /* Next, check listening connections. */ + for(c = 0; c < UIP_LISTENPORTS; ++c) { + if(tmp16 == uip_listenports[c]) { + goto found_listen; + } + } + + /* No matching connection found, so we send a RST packet. */ + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.synrst); + + reset: + /* We do not send resets in response to resets. */ + if(BUF->flags & TCP_RST) { + goto drop; + } + + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.rst); + + BUF->flags = TCP_RST | TCP_ACK; + uip_len = UIP_IPTCPH_LEN; + BUF->tcpoffset = 5 << 4; + + /* Flip the seqno and ackno fields in the TCP header. */ + c = BUF->seqno[3]; + BUF->seqno[3] = BUF->ackno[3]; + BUF->ackno[3] = c; + + c = BUF->seqno[2]; + BUF->seqno[2] = BUF->ackno[2]; + BUF->ackno[2] = c; + + c = BUF->seqno[1]; + BUF->seqno[1] = BUF->ackno[1]; + BUF->ackno[1] = c; + + c = BUF->seqno[0]; + BUF->seqno[0] = BUF->ackno[0]; + BUF->ackno[0] = c; + + /* We also have to increase the sequence number we are + acknowledging. If the least significant byte overflowed, we need + to propagate the carry to the other bytes as well. */ + if(++BUF->ackno[3] == 0) { + if(++BUF->ackno[2] == 0) { + if(++BUF->ackno[1] == 0) { + ++BUF->ackno[0]; + } + } + } + + /* Swap port numbers. */ + tmp16 = BUF->srcport; + BUF->srcport = BUF->destport; + BUF->destport = tmp16; + + /* Swap IP addresses. */ + uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->destipaddr, &BUF->srcipaddr); + uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_hostaddr); + + /* And send out the RST packet! */ + goto tcp_send_noconn; + + /* This label will be jumped to if we matched the incoming packet + with a connection in LISTEN. In that case, we should create a new + connection and send a SYNACK in return. */ + found_listen: + /* First we check if there are any connections available. Unused + connections are kept in the same table as used connections, but + unused ones have the tcpstate set to CLOSED. Also, connections in + TIME_WAIT are kept track of and we'll use the oldest one if no + CLOSED connections are found. Thanks to Eddie C. Dost for a very + nice algorithm for the TIME_WAIT search. */ + uip_connr = 0; + for(c = 0; c < UIP_CONNS; ++c) { + if(uip_conns[c].tcpstateflags == UIP_CLOSED) { + uip_connr = &uip_conns[c]; + break; + } + if(uip_conns[c].tcpstateflags == UIP_TIME_WAIT) { + if(uip_connr == 0 || + uip_conns[c].timer > uip_connr->timer) { + uip_connr = &uip_conns[c]; + } + } + } + + if(uip_connr == 0) { + /* All connections are used already, we drop packet and hope that + the remote end will retransmit the packet at a time when we + have more spare connections. */ + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.syndrop); + UIP_LOG("tcp: found no unused connections."); + goto drop; + } + uip_conn = uip_connr; + + /* Fill in the necessary fields for the new connection. */ + uip_connr->rto = uip_connr->timer = UIP_RTO; + uip_connr->sa = 0; + uip_connr->sv = 4; + uip_connr->nrtx = 0; + uip_connr->lport = BUF->destport; + uip_connr->rport = BUF->srcport; + uip_ipaddr_copy(&uip_connr->ripaddr, &BUF->srcipaddr); + uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_SYN_RCVD; + + uip_connr->snd_nxt[0] = iss[0]; + uip_connr->snd_nxt[1] = iss[1]; + uip_connr->snd_nxt[2] = iss[2]; + uip_connr->snd_nxt[3] = iss[3]; + uip_connr->len = 1; + + /* rcv_nxt should be the seqno from the incoming packet + 1. */ + uip_connr->rcv_nxt[3] = BUF->seqno[3]; + uip_connr->rcv_nxt[2] = BUF->seqno[2]; + uip_connr->rcv_nxt[1] = BUF->seqno[1]; + uip_connr->rcv_nxt[0] = BUF->seqno[0]; + uip_add_rcv_nxt(1); + + /* Parse the TCP MSS option, if present. */ + if((BUF->tcpoffset & 0xf0) > 0x50) { + for(c = 0; c < ((BUF->tcpoffset >> 4) - 5) << 2 ;) { + opt = uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + c]; + if(opt == TCP_OPT_END) { + /* End of options. */ + break; + } else if(opt == TCP_OPT_NOOP) { + ++c; + /* NOP option. */ + } else if(opt == TCP_OPT_MSS && + uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 1 + c] == TCP_OPT_MSS_LEN) { + /* An MSS option with the right option length. */ + tmp16 = ((u16_t)uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 2 + c] << 8) | + (u16_t)uip_buf[UIP_IPTCPH_LEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 3 + c]; + uip_connr->initialmss = uip_connr->mss = + tmp16 > UIP_TCP_MSS? UIP_TCP_MSS: tmp16; + + /* And we are done processing options. */ + break; + } else { + /* All other options have a length field, so that we easily + can skip past them. */ + if(uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 1 + c] == 0) { + /* If the length field is zero, the options are malformed + and we don't process them further. */ + break; + } + c += uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 1 + c]; + } + } + } + + /* Our response will be a SYNACK. */ +#if UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN + tcp_send_synack: + BUF->flags = TCP_ACK; + + tcp_send_syn: + BUF->flags |= TCP_SYN; +#else /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ + tcp_send_synack: + BUF->flags = TCP_SYN | TCP_ACK; +#endif /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ + + /* We send out the TCP Maximum Segment Size option with our + SYNACK. */ + BUF->optdata[0] = TCP_OPT_MSS; + BUF->optdata[1] = TCP_OPT_MSS_LEN; + BUF->optdata[2] = (UIP_TCP_MSS) / 256; + BUF->optdata[3] = (UIP_TCP_MSS) & 255; + uip_len = UIP_IPTCPH_LEN + TCP_OPT_MSS_LEN; + BUF->tcpoffset = ((UIP_TCPH_LEN + TCP_OPT_MSS_LEN) / 4) << 4; + goto tcp_send; + + /* This label will be jumped to if we found an active connection. */ + found: + uip_conn = uip_connr; + uip_flags = 0; + /* We do a very naive form of TCP reset processing; we just accept + any RST and kill our connection. We should in fact check if the + sequence number of this reset is within our advertised window + before we accept the reset. */ + if(BUF->flags & TCP_RST) { + uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_CLOSED; + UIP_LOG("tcp: got reset, aborting connection."); + uip_flags = UIP_ABORT; + UIP_APPCALL(); + goto drop; + } + /* Calculate the length of the data, if the application has sent + any data to us. */ + c = (BUF->tcpoffset >> 4) << 2; + /* uip_len will contain the length of the actual TCP data. This is + calculated by subtracing the length of the TCP header (in + c) and the length of the IP header (20 bytes). */ + uip_len = uip_len - c - UIP_IPH_LEN; + + /* First, check if the sequence number of the incoming packet is + what we're expecting next. If not, we send out an ACK with the + correct numbers in. */ + if(!(((uip_connr->tcpstateflags & UIP_TS_MASK) == UIP_SYN_SENT) && + ((BUF->flags & TCP_CTL) == (TCP_SYN | TCP_ACK)))) { + if((uip_len > 0 || ((BUF->flags & (TCP_SYN | TCP_FIN)) != 0)) && + (BUF->seqno[0] != uip_connr->rcv_nxt[0] || + BUF->seqno[1] != uip_connr->rcv_nxt[1] || + BUF->seqno[2] != uip_connr->rcv_nxt[2] || + BUF->seqno[3] != uip_connr->rcv_nxt[3])) { + goto tcp_send_ack; + } + } + + /* Next, check if the incoming segment acknowledges any outstanding + data. If so, we update the sequence number, reset the length of + the outstanding data, calculate RTT estimations, and reset the + retransmission timer. */ + if((BUF->flags & TCP_ACK) && uip_outstanding(uip_connr)) { + uip_add32(uip_connr->snd_nxt, uip_connr->len); + + if(BUF->ackno[0] == uip_acc32[0] && + BUF->ackno[1] == uip_acc32[1] && + BUF->ackno[2] == uip_acc32[2] && + BUF->ackno[3] == uip_acc32[3]) { + /* Update sequence number. */ + uip_connr->snd_nxt[0] = uip_acc32[0]; + uip_connr->snd_nxt[1] = uip_acc32[1]; + uip_connr->snd_nxt[2] = uip_acc32[2]; + uip_connr->snd_nxt[3] = uip_acc32[3]; + + /* Do RTT estimation, unless we have done retransmissions. */ + if(uip_connr->nrtx == 0) { + signed char m; + m = uip_connr->rto - uip_connr->timer; + /* This is taken directly from VJs original code in his paper */ + m = m - (uip_connr->sa >> 3); + uip_connr->sa += m; + if(m < 0) { + m = -m; + } + m = m - (uip_connr->sv >> 2); + uip_connr->sv += m; + uip_connr->rto = (uip_connr->sa >> 3) + uip_connr->sv; + + } + /* Set the acknowledged flag. */ + uip_flags = UIP_ACKDATA; + /* Reset the retransmission timer. */ + uip_connr->timer = uip_connr->rto; + + /* Reset length of outstanding data. */ + uip_connr->len = 0; + } + + } + + /* Do different things depending on in what state the connection is. */ + switch(uip_connr->tcpstateflags & UIP_TS_MASK) { + /* CLOSED and LISTEN are not handled here. CLOSE_WAIT is not + implemented, since we force the application to close when the + peer sends a FIN (hence the application goes directly from + ESTABLISHED to LAST_ACK). */ + case UIP_SYN_RCVD: + /* In SYN_RCVD we have sent out a SYNACK in response to a SYN, and + we are waiting for an ACK that acknowledges the data we sent + out the last time. Therefore, we want to have the UIP_ACKDATA + flag set. If so, we enter the ESTABLISHED state. */ + if(uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) { + uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_ESTABLISHED; + uip_flags = UIP_CONNECTED; + uip_connr->len = 0; + if(uip_len > 0) { + uip_flags |= UIP_NEWDATA; + uip_add_rcv_nxt(uip_len); + } + uip_slen = 0; + UIP_APPCALL(); + goto appsend; + } + goto drop; +#if UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN + case UIP_SYN_SENT: + /* In SYN_SENT, we wait for a SYNACK that is sent in response to + our SYN. The rcv_nxt is set to sequence number in the SYNACK + plus one, and we send an ACK. We move into the ESTABLISHED + state. */ + if((uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) && + (BUF->flags & TCP_CTL) == (TCP_SYN | TCP_ACK)) { + + /* Parse the TCP MSS option, if present. */ + if((BUF->tcpoffset & 0xf0) > 0x50) { + for(c = 0; c < ((BUF->tcpoffset >> 4) - 5) << 2 ;) { + opt = uip_buf[UIP_IPTCPH_LEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + c]; + if(opt == TCP_OPT_END) { + /* End of options. */ + break; + } else if(opt == TCP_OPT_NOOP) { + ++c; + /* NOP option. */ + } else if(opt == TCP_OPT_MSS && + uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 1 + c] == TCP_OPT_MSS_LEN) { + /* An MSS option with the right option length. */ + tmp16 = (uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 2 + c] << 8) | + uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 3 + c]; + uip_connr->initialmss = + uip_connr->mss = tmp16 > UIP_TCP_MSS? UIP_TCP_MSS: tmp16; + + /* And we are done processing options. */ + break; + } else { + /* All other options have a length field, so that we easily + can skip past them. */ + if(uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 1 + c] == 0) { + /* If the length field is zero, the options are malformed + and we don't process them further. */ + break; + } + c += uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 1 + c]; + } + } + } + uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_ESTABLISHED; + uip_connr->rcv_nxt[0] = BUF->seqno[0]; + uip_connr->rcv_nxt[1] = BUF->seqno[1]; + uip_connr->rcv_nxt[2] = BUF->seqno[2]; + uip_connr->rcv_nxt[3] = BUF->seqno[3]; + uip_add_rcv_nxt(1); + uip_flags = UIP_CONNECTED | UIP_NEWDATA; + uip_connr->len = 0; + uip_len = 0; + uip_slen = 0; + UIP_APPCALL(); + goto appsend; + } + /* Inform the application that the connection failed */ + uip_flags = UIP_ABORT; + UIP_APPCALL(); + /* The connection is closed after we send the RST */ + uip_conn->tcpstateflags = UIP_CLOSED; + goto reset; +#endif /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ + + case UIP_ESTABLISHED: + /* In the ESTABLISHED state, we call upon the application to feed + data into the uip_buf. If the UIP_ACKDATA flag is set, the + application should put new data into the buffer, otherwise we are + retransmitting an old segment, and the application should put that + data into the buffer. + + If the incoming packet is a FIN, we should close the connection on + this side as well, and we send out a FIN and enter the LAST_ACK + state. We require that there is no outstanding data; otherwise the + sequence numbers will be screwed up. */ + + if(BUF->flags & TCP_FIN && !(uip_connr->tcpstateflags & UIP_STOPPED)) { + if(uip_outstanding(uip_connr)) { + goto drop; + } + uip_add_rcv_nxt(1 + uip_len); + uip_flags |= UIP_CLOSE; + if(uip_len > 0) { + uip_flags |= UIP_NEWDATA; + } + UIP_APPCALL(); + uip_connr->len = 1; + uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_LAST_ACK; + uip_connr->nrtx = 0; + tcp_send_finack: + BUF->flags = TCP_FIN | TCP_ACK; + goto tcp_send_nodata; + } + + /* Check the URG flag. If this is set, the segment carries urgent + data that we must pass to the application. */ + if((BUF->flags & TCP_URG) != 0) { +#if UIP_URGDATA > 0 + uip_urglen = (BUF->urgp[0] << 8) | BUF->urgp[1]; + if(uip_urglen > uip_len) { + /* There is more urgent data in the next segment to come. */ + uip_urglen = uip_len; + } + uip_add_rcv_nxt(uip_urglen); + uip_len -= uip_urglen; + uip_urgdata = uip_appdata; + uip_appdata += uip_urglen; + } else { + uip_urglen = 0; +#else /* UIP_URGDATA > 0 */ + uip_appdata = ((char *)uip_appdata) + ((BUF->urgp[0] << 8) | BUF->urgp[1]); + uip_len -= (BUF->urgp[0] << 8) | BUF->urgp[1]; +#endif /* UIP_URGDATA > 0 */ + } + + /* If uip_len > 0 we have TCP data in the packet, and we flag this + by setting the UIP_NEWDATA flag and update the sequence number + we acknowledge. If the application has stopped the dataflow + using uip_stop(), we must not accept any data packets from the + remote host. */ + if(uip_len > 0 && !(uip_connr->tcpstateflags & UIP_STOPPED)) { + uip_flags |= UIP_NEWDATA; + uip_add_rcv_nxt(uip_len); + } + + /* Check if the available buffer space advertised by the other end + is smaller than the initial MSS for this connection. If so, we + set the current MSS to the window size to ensure that the + application does not send more data than the other end can + handle. + + If the remote host advertises a zero window, we set the MSS to + the initial MSS so that the application will send an entire MSS + of data. This data will not be acknowledged by the receiver, + and the application will retransmit it. This is called the + "persistent timer" and uses the retransmission mechanism. + */ + tmp16 = ((u16_t)BUF->wnd[0] << 8) + (u16_t)BUF->wnd[1]; + if(tmp16 > uip_connr->initialmss || + tmp16 == 0) { + tmp16 = uip_connr->initialmss; + } + uip_connr->mss = tmp16; + + /* If this packet constitutes an ACK for outstanding data (flagged + by the UIP_ACKDATA flag, we should call the application since it + might want to send more data. If the incoming packet had data + from the peer (as flagged by the UIP_NEWDATA flag), the + application must also be notified. + + When the application is called, the global variable uip_len + contains the length of the incoming data. The application can + access the incoming data through the global pointer + uip_appdata, which usually points UIP_IPTCPH_LEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + bytes into the uip_buf array. + + If the application wishes to send any data, this data should be + put into the uip_appdata and the length of the data should be + put into uip_len. If the application don't have any data to + send, uip_len must be set to 0. */ + if(uip_flags & (UIP_NEWDATA | UIP_ACKDATA)) { + uip_slen = 0; + UIP_APPCALL(); + + appsend: + + if(uip_flags & UIP_ABORT) { + uip_slen = 0; + uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_CLOSED; + BUF->flags = TCP_RST | TCP_ACK; + goto tcp_send_nodata; + } + + if(uip_flags & UIP_CLOSE) { + uip_slen = 0; + uip_connr->len = 1; + uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_FIN_WAIT_1; + uip_connr->nrtx = 0; + BUF->flags = TCP_FIN | TCP_ACK; + goto tcp_send_nodata; + } + + /* If uip_slen > 0, the application has data to be sent. */ + if(uip_slen > 0) { + + /* If the connection has acknowledged data, the contents of + the ->len variable should be discarded. */ + if((uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) != 0) { + uip_connr->len = 0; + } + + /* If the ->len variable is non-zero the connection has + already data in transit and cannot send anymore right + now. */ + if(uip_connr->len == 0) { + + /* The application cannot send more than what is allowed by + the mss (the minumum of the MSS and the available + window). */ + if(uip_slen > uip_connr->mss) { + uip_slen = uip_connr->mss; + } + + /* Remember how much data we send out now so that we know + when everything has been acknowledged. */ + uip_connr->len = uip_slen; + } else { + + /* If the application already had unacknowledged data, we + make sure that the application does not send (i.e., + retransmit) out more than it previously sent out. */ + uip_slen = uip_connr->len; + } + } + uip_connr->nrtx = 0; + apprexmit: + uip_appdata = uip_sappdata; + + /* If the application has data to be sent, or if the incoming + packet had new data in it, we must send out a packet. */ + if(uip_slen > 0 && uip_connr->len > 0) { + /* Add the length of the IP and TCP headers. */ + uip_len = uip_connr->len + UIP_TCPIP_HLEN; + /* We always set the ACK flag in response packets. */ + BUF->flags = TCP_ACK | TCP_PSH; + /* Send the packet. */ + goto tcp_send_noopts; + } + /* If there is no data to send, just send out a pure ACK if + there is newdata. */ + if(uip_flags & UIP_NEWDATA) { + uip_len = UIP_TCPIP_HLEN; + BUF->flags = TCP_ACK; + goto tcp_send_noopts; + } + } + goto drop; + case UIP_LAST_ACK: + /* We can close this connection if the peer has acknowledged our + FIN. This is indicated by the UIP_ACKDATA flag. */ + if(uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) { + uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_CLOSED; + uip_flags = UIP_CLOSE; + UIP_APPCALL(); + } + break; + + case UIP_FIN_WAIT_1: + /* The application has closed the connection, but the remote host + hasn't closed its end yet. Thus we do nothing but wait for a + FIN from the other side. */ + if(uip_len > 0) { + uip_add_rcv_nxt(uip_len); + } + if(BUF->flags & TCP_FIN) { + if(uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) { + uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_TIME_WAIT; + uip_connr->timer = 0; + uip_connr->len = 0; + } else { + uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_CLOSING; + } + uip_add_rcv_nxt(1); + uip_flags = UIP_CLOSE; + UIP_APPCALL(); + goto tcp_send_ack; + } else if(uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) { + uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_FIN_WAIT_2; + uip_connr->len = 0; + goto drop; + } + if(uip_len > 0) { + goto tcp_send_ack; + } + goto drop; + + case UIP_FIN_WAIT_2: + if(uip_len > 0) { + uip_add_rcv_nxt(uip_len); + } + if(BUF->flags & TCP_FIN) { + uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_TIME_WAIT; + uip_connr->timer = 0; + uip_add_rcv_nxt(1); + uip_flags = UIP_CLOSE; + UIP_APPCALL(); + goto tcp_send_ack; + } + if(uip_len > 0) { + goto tcp_send_ack; + } + goto drop; + + case UIP_TIME_WAIT: + goto tcp_send_ack; + + case UIP_CLOSING: + if(uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) { + uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_TIME_WAIT; + uip_connr->timer = 0; + } + } + goto drop; + + /* We jump here when we are ready to send the packet, and just want + to set the appropriate TCP sequence numbers in the TCP header. */ + tcp_send_ack: + BUF->flags = TCP_ACK; + + tcp_send_nodata: + uip_len = UIP_IPTCPH_LEN; + + tcp_send_noopts: + BUF->tcpoffset = (UIP_TCPH_LEN / 4) << 4; + + /* We're done with the input processing. We are now ready to send a + reply. Our job is to fill in all the fields of the TCP and IP + headers before calculating the checksum and finally send the + packet. */ + tcp_send: + BUF->ackno[0] = uip_connr->rcv_nxt[0]; + BUF->ackno[1] = uip_connr->rcv_nxt[1]; + BUF->ackno[2] = uip_connr->rcv_nxt[2]; + BUF->ackno[3] = uip_connr->rcv_nxt[3]; + + BUF->seqno[0] = uip_connr->snd_nxt[0]; + BUF->seqno[1] = uip_connr->snd_nxt[1]; + BUF->seqno[2] = uip_connr->snd_nxt[2]; + BUF->seqno[3] = uip_connr->snd_nxt[3]; + + BUF->proto = UIP_PROTO_TCP; + + BUF->srcport = uip_connr->lport; + BUF->destport = uip_connr->rport; + + uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_hostaddr); + uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->destipaddr, &uip_connr->ripaddr); + + if(uip_connr->tcpstateflags & UIP_STOPPED) { + /* If the connection has issued uip_stop(), we advertise a zero + window so that the remote host will stop sending data. */ + BUF->wnd[0] = BUF->wnd[1] = 0; + } else { + BUF->wnd[0] = ((UIP_RECEIVE_WINDOW) >> 8); + BUF->wnd[1] = ((UIP_RECEIVE_WINDOW) & 0xff); + } + + tcp_send_noconn: + BUF->ttl = UIP_TTL; +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 + /* For IPv6, the IP length field does not include the IPv6 IP header + length. */ + BUF->len[0] = ((uip_len - UIP_IPH_LEN) >> 8); + BUF->len[1] = ((uip_len - UIP_IPH_LEN) & 0xff); +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + BUF->len[0] = (uip_len >> 8); + BUF->len[1] = (uip_len & 0xff); +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + + BUF->urgp[0] = BUF->urgp[1] = 0; + + /* Calculate TCP checksum. */ + BUF->tcpchksum = 0; + BUF->tcpchksum = ~(uip_tcpchksum()); + + ip_send_nolen: +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 + BUF->vtc = 0x60; + BUF->tcflow = 0x00; + BUF->flow = 0x00; +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + BUF->vhl = 0x45; + BUF->tos = 0; + BUF->ipoffset[0] = BUF->ipoffset[1] = 0; + ++ipid; + BUF->ipid[0] = ipid >> 8; + BUF->ipid[1] = ipid & 0xff; + /* Calculate IP checksum. */ + BUF->ipchksum = 0; + BUF->ipchksum = ~(uip_ipchksum()); + DEBUG_PRINTF("uip ip_send_nolen: checksum 0x%04x\n", uip_ipchksum()); +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.sent); +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 + send: +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + DEBUG_PRINTF("Sending packet with length %d (%d)\n", uip_len, + (BUF->len[0] << 8) | BUF->len[1]); + + UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.sent); + /* Return and let the caller do the actual transmission. */ + uip_flags = 0; + return; + + drop: + uip_len = 0; + uip_flags = 0; + return; +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +u16_t +htons(u16_t val) +{ + return HTONS(val); +} + +u32_t +htonl(u32_t val) +{ + return HTONL(val); +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_send(const void *data, int len) +{ + int copylen; +#define MIN(a,b) ((a) < (b)? (a): (b)) + copylen = MIN(len, UIP_BUFSIZE - UIP_LLH_LEN - UIP_TCPIP_HLEN - + (int)((char *)uip_sappdata - (char *)&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_TCPIP_HLEN])); + if(copylen > 0) { + uip_slen = copylen; + if(data != uip_sappdata) { + memcpy(uip_sappdata, (data), uip_slen); + } + } +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** @} */ +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7b87a2c77c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip.h @@ -0,0 +1,2130 @@ + +/** + * \addtogroup uip + * @{ + */ + +/** + * \file + * Header file for the uIP TCP/IP stack. + * \author Adam Dunkels <adam@dunkels.com> + * \author Julien Abeille <jabeille@cisco.com> (IPv6 related code) + * \author Mathilde Durvy <mdurvy@cisco.com> (IPv6 related code) + * + * The uIP TCP/IP stack header file contains definitions for a number + * of C macros that are used by uIP programs as well as internal uIP + * structures, TCP/IP header structures and function declarations. + * + */ + +/* + * Copyright (c) 2001-2003, Adam Dunkels. + * All rights reserved. + * + * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without + * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions + * are met: + * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright + * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. + * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright + * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the + * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. + * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote + * products derived from this software without specific prior + * written permission. + * + * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS + * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED + * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE + * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY + * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL + * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE + * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS + * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, + * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING + * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS + * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. + * + * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. + * + * $Id: uip.h,v 1.24 2009/04/06 13:18:50 nvt-se Exp $ + * + */ + +#ifndef __UIP_H__ +#define __UIP_H__ + +#include "uipopt.h" + +/** + * Representation of an IP address. + * + */ +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +typedef union uip_ip6addr_t { + u8_t u8[16]; /* Initialiser, must come first!!! */ + u16_t u16[8]; +} uip_ip6addr_t; + +typedef uip_ip6addr_t uip_ipaddr_t; +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +typedef union uip_ip4addr_t { + u8_t u8[4]; /* Initialiser, must come first!!! */ + u16_t u16[2]; +#if 0 + u32_t u32; +#endif +} uip_ip4addr_t; +typedef uip_ip4addr_t uip_ipaddr_t; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +/** \brief 16 bit 802.15.4 address */ +struct uip_802154_shortaddr { + u8_t addr[2]; +}; +/** \brief 64 bit 802.15.4 address */ +struct uip_802154_longaddr { + u8_t addr[8]; +}; + +/** \brief 802.11 address */ +struct uip_80211_addr { + u8_t addr[6]; +}; + +/** \brief 802.3 address */ +struct uip_eth_addr { + u8_t addr[6]; +}; + +#if UIP_CONF_LL_802154 +/** \brief 802.15.4 address */ +typedef struct uip_802154_longaddr uip_lladdr_t; +#define UIP_802154_SHORTADDR_LEN 2 +#define UIP_802154_LONGADDR_LEN 8 +#define UIP_LLADDR_LEN UIP_802154_LONGADDR_LEN +#else /*UIP_CONF_LL_802154*/ +#if UIP_CONF_LL_80211 +/** \brief 802.11 address */ +typedef struct uip_80211_addr uip_lladdr_t; +#define UIP_LLADDR_LEN 6 +#else /*UIP_CONF_LL_80211*/ +/** \brief Ethernet address */ +typedef struct uip_eth_addr uip_lladdr_t; +#define UIP_LLADDR_LEN 6 +#endif /*UIP_CONF_LL_80211*/ +#endif /*UIP_CONF_LL_802154*/ + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* First, the functions that should be called from the + * system. Initialization, the periodic timer, and incoming packets are + * handled by the following three functions. + */ +/** + * \defgroup uipconffunc uIP configuration functions + * @{ + * + * The uIP configuration functions are used for setting run-time + * parameters in uIP such as IP addresses. + */ + +/** + * Set the IP address of this host. + * + * The IP address is represented as a 4-byte array where the first + * octet of the IP address is put in the first member of the 4-byte + * array. + * + * Example: + \code + + uip_ipaddr_t addr; + + uip_ipaddr(&addr, 192,168,1,2); + uip_sethostaddr(&addr); + + \endcode + * \param addr A pointer to an IP address of type uip_ipaddr_t; + * + * \sa uip_ipaddr() + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_sethostaddr(addr) uip_ipaddr_copy(&uip_hostaddr, (addr)) + +/** + * Get the IP address of this host. + * + * The IP address is represented as a 4-byte array where the first + * octet of the IP address is put in the first member of the 4-byte + * array. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t hostaddr; + + uip_gethostaddr(&hostaddr); + \endcode + * \param addr A pointer to a uip_ipaddr_t variable that will be + * filled in with the currently configured IP address. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_gethostaddr(addr) uip_ipaddr_copy((addr), &uip_hostaddr) + +/** + * Set the default router's IP address. + * + * \param addr A pointer to a uip_ipaddr_t variable containing the IP + * address of the default router. + * + * \sa uip_ipaddr() + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_setdraddr(addr) uip_ipaddr_copy(&uip_draddr, (addr)) + +/** + * Set the netmask. + * + * \param addr A pointer to a uip_ipaddr_t variable containing the IP + * address of the netmask. + * + * \sa uip_ipaddr() + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_setnetmask(addr) uip_ipaddr_copy(&uip_netmask, (addr)) + + +/** + * Get the default router's IP address. + * + * \param addr A pointer to a uip_ipaddr_t variable that will be + * filled in with the IP address of the default router. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_getdraddr(addr) uip_ipaddr_copy((addr), &uip_draddr) + +/** + * Get the netmask. + * + * \param addr A pointer to a uip_ipaddr_t variable that will be + * filled in with the value of the netmask. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_getnetmask(addr) uip_ipaddr_copy((addr), &uip_netmask) + +/** @} */ + +/** + * \defgroup uipinit uIP initialization functions + * @{ + * + * The uIP initialization functions are used for booting uIP. + */ + +/** + * uIP initialization function. + * + * This function should be called at boot up to initialize the uIP + * TCP/IP stack. + */ +void uip_init(void); + +/** + * uIP initialization function. + * + * This function may be used at boot time to set the initial ip_id. + */ +void uip_setipid(u16_t id); + +/** @} */ + +/** + * \defgroup uipdevfunc uIP device driver functions + * @{ + * + * These functions are used by a network device driver for interacting + * with uIP. + */ + +/** + * Process an incoming packet. + * + * This function should be called when the device driver has received + * a packet from the network. The packet from the device driver must + * be present in the uip_buf buffer, and the length of the packet + * should be placed in the uip_len variable. + * + * When the function returns, there may be an outbound packet placed + * in the uip_buf packet buffer. If so, the uip_len variable is set to + * the length of the packet. If no packet is to be sent out, the + * uip_len variable is set to 0. + * + * The usual way of calling the function is presented by the source + * code below. + \code + uip_len = devicedriver_poll(); + if(uip_len > 0) { + uip_input(); + if(uip_len > 0) { + devicedriver_send(); + } + } + \endcode + * + * \note If you are writing a uIP device driver that needs ARP + * (Address Resolution Protocol), e.g., when running uIP over + * Ethernet, you will need to call the uIP ARP code before calling + * this function: + \code + #define BUF ((struct uip_eth_hdr *)&uip_buf[0]) + uip_len = ethernet_devicedrver_poll(); + if(uip_len > 0) { + if(BUF->type == HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_IP)) { + uip_arp_ipin(); + uip_input(); + if(uip_len > 0) { + uip_arp_out(); + ethernet_devicedriver_send(); + } + } else if(BUF->type == HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_ARP)) { + uip_arp_arpin(); + if(uip_len > 0) { + ethernet_devicedriver_send(); + } + } + \endcode + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_input() uip_process(UIP_DATA) + + +/** + * Periodic processing for a connection identified by its number. + * + * This function does the necessary periodic processing (timers, + * polling) for a uIP TCP connection, and should be called when the + * periodic uIP timer goes off. It should be called for every + * connection, regardless of whether they are open of closed. + * + * When the function returns, it may have an outbound packet waiting + * for service in the uIP packet buffer, and if so the uip_len + * variable is set to a value larger than zero. The device driver + * should be called to send out the packet. + * + * The usual way of calling the function is through a for() loop like + * this: + \code + for(i = 0; i < UIP_CONNS; ++i) { + uip_periodic(i); + if(uip_len > 0) { + devicedriver_send(); + } + } + \endcode + * + * \note If you are writing a uIP device driver that needs ARP + * (Address Resolution Protocol), e.g., when running uIP over + * Ethernet, you will need to call the uip_arp_out() function before + * calling the device driver: + \code + for(i = 0; i < UIP_CONNS; ++i) { + uip_periodic(i); + if(uip_len > 0) { + uip_arp_out(); + ethernet_devicedriver_send(); + } + } + \endcode + * + * \param conn The number of the connection which is to be periodically polled. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#if UIP_TCP +#define uip_periodic(conn) do { uip_conn = &uip_conns[conn]; \ + uip_process(UIP_TIMER); } while (0) + +/** + * + * + */ +#define uip_conn_active(conn) (uip_conns[conn].tcpstateflags != UIP_CLOSED) + +/** + * Perform periodic processing for a connection identified by a pointer + * to its structure. + * + * Same as uip_periodic() but takes a pointer to the actual uip_conn + * struct instead of an integer as its argument. This function can be + * used to force periodic processing of a specific connection. + * + * \param conn A pointer to the uip_conn struct for the connection to + * be processed. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_periodic_conn(conn) do { uip_conn = conn; \ + uip_process(UIP_TIMER); } while (0) + +/** + * Request that a particular connection should be polled. + * + * Similar to uip_periodic_conn() but does not perform any timer + * processing. The application is polled for new data. + * + * \param conn A pointer to the uip_conn struct for the connection to + * be processed. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_poll_conn(conn) do { uip_conn = conn; \ + uip_process(UIP_POLL_REQUEST); } while (0) + +#endif /* UIP_TCP */ + +#if UIP_UDP +/** + * Periodic processing for a UDP connection identified by its number. + * + * This function is essentially the same as uip_periodic(), but for + * UDP connections. It is called in a similar fashion as the + * uip_periodic() function: + \code + for(i = 0; i < UIP_UDP_CONNS; i++) { + uip_udp_periodic(i); + if(uip_len > 0) { + devicedriver_send(); + } + } + \endcode + * + * \note As for the uip_periodic() function, special care has to be + * taken when using uIP together with ARP and Ethernet: + \code + for(i = 0; i < UIP_UDP_CONNS; i++) { + uip_udp_periodic(i); + if(uip_len > 0) { + uip_arp_out(); + ethernet_devicedriver_send(); + } + } + \endcode + * + * \param conn The number of the UDP connection to be processed. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_udp_periodic(conn) do { uip_udp_conn = &uip_udp_conns[conn]; \ + uip_process(UIP_UDP_TIMER); } while(0) + +/** + * Periodic processing for a UDP connection identified by a pointer to + * its structure. + * + * Same as uip_udp_periodic() but takes a pointer to the actual + * uip_conn struct instead of an integer as its argument. This + * function can be used to force periodic processing of a specific + * connection. + * + * \param conn A pointer to the uip_udp_conn struct for the connection + * to be processed. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_udp_periodic_conn(conn) do { uip_udp_conn = conn; \ + uip_process(UIP_UDP_TIMER); } while(0) +#endif /* UIP_UDP */ + +/** \brief Abandon the reassembly of the current packet */ +void uip_reass_over(void); + +/** + * The uIP packet buffer. + * + * The uip_buf array is used to hold incoming and outgoing + * packets. The device driver should place incoming data into this + * buffer. When sending data, the device driver should read the link + * level headers and the TCP/IP headers from this buffer. The size of + * the link level headers is configured by the UIP_LLH_LEN define. + * + * \note The application data need not be placed in this buffer, so + * the device driver must read it from the place pointed to by the + * uip_appdata pointer as illustrated by the following example: + \code + void + devicedriver_send(void) + { + hwsend(&uip_buf[0], UIP_LLH_LEN); + if(uip_len <= UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_TCPIP_HLEN) { + hwsend(&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN], uip_len - UIP_LLH_LEN); + } else { + hwsend(&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN], UIP_TCPIP_HLEN); + hwsend(uip_appdata, uip_len - UIP_TCPIP_HLEN - UIP_LLH_LEN); + } + } + \endcode +*/ +extern u8_t uip_buf[UIP_BUFSIZE+2]; + + + +/** @} */ + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Functions that are used by the uIP application program. Opening and + * closing connections, sending and receiving data, etc. is all + * handled by the functions below. + */ +/** + * \defgroup uipappfunc uIP application functions + * @{ + * + * Functions used by an application running of top of uIP. + */ + +/** + * Start listening to the specified port. + * + * \note Since this function expects the port number in network byte + * order, a conversion using HTONS() or htons() is necessary. + * + \code + uip_listen(HTONS(80)); + \endcode + * + * \param port A 16-bit port number in network byte order. + */ +void uip_listen(u16_t port); + +/** + * Stop listening to the specified port. + * + * \note Since this function expects the port number in network byte + * order, a conversion using HTONS() or htons() is necessary. + * + \code + uip_unlisten(HTONS(80)); + \endcode + * + * \param port A 16-bit port number in network byte order. + */ +void uip_unlisten(u16_t port); + +/** + * Connect to a remote host using TCP. + * + * This function is used to start a new connection to the specified + * port on the specified host. It allocates a new connection identifier, + * sets the connection to the SYN_SENT state and sets the + * retransmission timer to 0. This will cause a TCP SYN segment to be + * sent out the next time this connection is periodically processed, + * which usually is done within 0.5 seconds after the call to + * uip_connect(). + * + * \note This function is available only if support for active open + * has been configured by defining UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN to 1 in uipopt.h. + * + * \note Since this function requires the port number to be in network + * byte order, a conversion using HTONS() or htons() is necessary. + * + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr; + + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr, 192,168,1,2); + uip_connect(&ipaddr, HTONS(80)); + \endcode + * + * \param ripaddr The IP address of the remote host. + * + * \param port A 16-bit port number in network byte order. + * + * \return A pointer to the uIP connection identifier for the new connection, + * or NULL if no connection could be allocated. + * + */ +struct uip_conn *uip_connect(uip_ipaddr_t *ripaddr, u16_t port); + + + +/** + * \internal + * + * Check if a connection has outstanding (i.e., unacknowledged) data. + * + * \param conn A pointer to the uip_conn structure for the connection. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_outstanding(conn) ((conn)->len) + +/** + * Send data on the current connection. + * + * This function is used to send out a single segment of TCP + * data. Only applications that have been invoked by uIP for event + * processing can send data. + * + * The amount of data that actually is sent out after a call to this + * function is determined by the maximum amount of data TCP allows. uIP + * will automatically crop the data so that only the appropriate + * amount of data is sent. The function uip_mss() can be used to query + * uIP for the amount of data that actually will be sent. + * + * \note This function does not guarantee that the sent data will + * arrive at the destination. If the data is lost in the network, the + * application will be invoked with the uip_rexmit() event being + * set. The application will then have to resend the data using this + * function. + * + * \param data A pointer to the data which is to be sent. + * + * \param len The maximum amount of data bytes to be sent. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +void uip_send(const void *data, int len); + +/** + * The length of any incoming data that is currently available (if available) + * in the uip_appdata buffer. + * + * The test function uip_data() must first be used to check if there + * is any data available at all. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +/*void uip_datalen(void);*/ +#define uip_datalen() uip_len + +/** + * The length of any out-of-band data (urgent data) that has arrived + * on the connection. + * + * \note The configuration parameter UIP_URGDATA must be set for this + * function to be enabled. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_urgdatalen() uip_urglen + +/** + * Close the current connection. + * + * This function will close the current connection in a nice way. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_close() (uip_flags = UIP_CLOSE) + +/** + * Abort the current connection. + * + * This function will abort (reset) the current connection, and is + * usually used when an error has occurred that prevents using the + * uip_close() function. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_abort() (uip_flags = UIP_ABORT) + +/** + * Tell the sending host to stop sending data. + * + * This function will close our receiver's window so that we stop + * receiving data for the current connection. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_stop() (uip_conn->tcpstateflags |= UIP_STOPPED) + +/** + * Find out if the current connection has been previously stopped with + * uip_stop(). + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_stopped(conn) ((conn)->tcpstateflags & UIP_STOPPED) + +/** + * Restart the current connection, if is has previously been stopped + * with uip_stop(). + * + * This function will open the receiver's window again so that we + * start receiving data for the current connection. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_restart() do { uip_flags |= UIP_NEWDATA; \ + uip_conn->tcpstateflags &= ~UIP_STOPPED; \ + } while(0) + + +/* uIP tests that can be made to determine in what state the current + connection is, and what the application function should do. */ + +/** + * Is the current connection a UDP connection? + * + * This function checks whether the current connection is a UDP connection. + * + * \hideinitializer + * + */ +#define uip_udpconnection() (uip_conn == NULL) + +/** + * Is new incoming data available? + * + * Will reduce to non-zero if there is new data for the application + * present at the uip_appdata pointer. The size of the data is + * available through the uip_len variable. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_newdata() (uip_flags & UIP_NEWDATA) + +/** + * Has previously sent data been acknowledged? + * + * Will reduce to non-zero if the previously sent data has been + * acknowledged by the remote host. This means that the application + * can send new data. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_acked() (uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) + +/** + * Has the connection just been connected? + * + * Reduces to non-zero if the current connection has been connected to + * a remote host. This will happen both if the connection has been + * actively opened (with uip_connect()) or passively opened (with + * uip_listen()). + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_connected() (uip_flags & UIP_CONNECTED) + +/** + * Has the connection been closed by the other end? + * + * Is non-zero if the connection has been closed by the remote + * host. The application may then do the necessary clean-ups. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_closed() (uip_flags & UIP_CLOSE) + +/** + * Has the connection been aborted by the other end? + * + * Non-zero if the current connection has been aborted (reset) by the + * remote host. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_aborted() (uip_flags & UIP_ABORT) + +/** + * Has the connection timed out? + * + * Non-zero if the current connection has been aborted due to too many + * retransmissions. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_timedout() (uip_flags & UIP_TIMEDOUT) + +/** + * Do we need to retransmit previously data? + * + * Reduces to non-zero if the previously sent data has been lost in + * the network, and the application should retransmit it. The + * application should send the exact same data as it did the last + * time, using the uip_send() function. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_rexmit() (uip_flags & UIP_REXMIT) + +/** + * Is the connection being polled by uIP? + * + * Is non-zero if the reason the application is invoked is that the + * current connection has been idle for a while and should be + * polled. + * + * The polling event can be used for sending data without having to + * wait for the remote host to send data. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_poll() (uip_flags & UIP_POLL) + +/** + * Get the initial maximum segment size (MSS) of the current + * connection. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_initialmss() (uip_conn->initialmss) + +/** + * Get the current maximum segment size that can be sent on the current + * connection. + * + * The current maximum segment size that can be sent on the + * connection is computed from the receiver's window and the MSS of + * the connection (which also is available by calling + * uip_initialmss()). + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_mss() (uip_conn->mss) + +/** + * Set up a new UDP connection. + * + * This function sets up a new UDP connection. The function will + * automatically allocate an unused local port for the new + * connection. However, another port can be chosen by using the + * uip_udp_bind() call, after the uip_udp_new() function has been + * called. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t addr; + struct uip_udp_conn *c; + + uip_ipaddr(&addr, 192,168,2,1); + c = uip_udp_new(&addr, HTONS(12345)); + if(c != NULL) { + uip_udp_bind(c, HTONS(12344)); + } + \endcode + * \param ripaddr The IP address of the remote host. + * + * \param rport The remote port number in network byte order. + * + * \return The uip_udp_conn structure for the new connection or NULL + * if no connection could be allocated. + */ +struct uip_udp_conn *uip_udp_new(const uip_ipaddr_t *ripaddr, u16_t rport); + +/** + * Removed a UDP connection. + * + * \param conn A pointer to the uip_udp_conn structure for the connection. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_udp_remove(conn) (conn)->lport = 0 + +/** + * Bind a UDP connection to a local port. + * + * \param conn A pointer to the uip_udp_conn structure for the + * connection. + * + * \param port The local port number, in network byte order. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_udp_bind(conn, port) (conn)->lport = port + +/** + * Send a UDP datagram of length len on the current connection. + * + * This function can only be called in response to a UDP event (poll + * or newdata). The data must be present in the uip_buf buffer, at the + * place pointed to by the uip_appdata pointer. + * + * \param len The length of the data in the uip_buf buffer. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_udp_send(len) uip_send((char *)uip_appdata, len) + +/** @} */ + +/* uIP convenience and converting functions. */ + +/** + * \defgroup uipconvfunc uIP conversion functions + * @{ + * + * These functions can be used for converting between different data + * formats used by uIP. + */ + +/** + * Convert an IP address to four bytes separated by commas. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr; + printf("ipaddr=%d.%d.%d.%d\n", uip_ipaddr_to_quad(&ipaddr)); + \endcode + * + * \param a A pointer to a uip_ipaddr_t. + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_ipaddr_to_quad(a) (a)->u8[0],(a)->u8[1],(a)->u8[2],(a)->u8[3] + +/** + * Construct an IP address from four bytes. + * + * This function constructs an IP address of the type that uIP handles + * internally from four bytes. The function is handy for specifying IP + * addresses to use with e.g. the uip_connect() function. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr; + struct uip_conn *c; + + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr, 192,168,1,2); + c = uip_connect(&ipaddr, HTONS(80)); + \endcode + * + * \param addr A pointer to a uip_ipaddr_t variable that will be + * filled in with the IP address. + * + * \param addr0 The first octet of the IP address. + * \param addr1 The second octet of the IP address. + * \param addr2 The third octet of the IP address. + * \param addr3 The forth octet of the IP address. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_ipaddr(addr, addr0,addr1,addr2,addr3) do { \ + (addr)->u8[0] = addr0; \ + (addr)->u8[1] = addr1; \ + (addr)->u8[2] = addr2; \ + (addr)->u8[3] = addr3; \ + } while(0) + +/** + * Construct an IPv6 address from eight 16-bit words. + * + * This function constructs an IPv6 address. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_ip6addr(addr, addr0,addr1,addr2,addr3,addr4,addr5,addr6,addr7) do { \ + (addr)->u16[0] = HTONS(addr0); \ + (addr)->u16[1] = HTONS(addr1); \ + (addr)->u16[2] = HTONS(addr2); \ + (addr)->u16[3] = HTONS(addr3); \ + (addr)->u16[4] = HTONS(addr4); \ + (addr)->u16[5] = HTONS(addr5); \ + (addr)->u16[6] = HTONS(addr6); \ + (addr)->u16[7] = HTONS(addr7); \ + } while(0) + +/** + * Construct an IPv6 address from sixteen 8-bit words. + * + * This function constructs an IPv6 address. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_ip6addr_u8(addr, addr0,addr1,addr2,addr3,addr4,addr5,addr6,addr7,addr8,addr9,addr10,addr11,addr12,addr13,addr14,addr15) do { \ + (addr)->u8[0] = addr0; \ + (addr)->u8[1] = addr1; \ + (addr)->u8[2] = addr2; \ + (addr)->u8[3] = addr3; \ + (addr)->u8[4] = addr4; \ + (addr)->u8[5] = addr5; \ + (addr)->u8[6] = addr6; \ + (addr)->u8[7] = addr7; \ + (addr)->u8[8] = addr8; \ + (addr)->u8[9] = addr9; \ + (addr)->u8[10] = addr10; \ + (addr)->u8[11] = addr11; \ + (addr)->u8[12] = addr12; \ + (addr)->u8[13] = addr13; \ + (addr)->u8[14] = addr14; \ + (addr)->u8[15] = addr15; \ + } while(0) + + +/** + * Copy an IP address to another IP address. + * + * Copies an IP address from one place to another. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr1, ipaddr2; + + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr1, 192,16,1,2); + uip_ipaddr_copy(&ipaddr2, &ipaddr1); + \endcode + * + * \param dest The destination for the copy. + * \param src The source from where to copy. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifndef uip_ipaddr_copy +#define uip_ipaddr_copy(dest, src) (*(dest) = *(src)) +#endif + +/** + * Compare two IP addresses + * + * Compares two IP addresses. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr1, ipaddr2; + + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr1, 192,16,1,2); + if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&ipaddr2, &ipaddr1)) { + printf("They are the same"); + } + \endcode + * + * \param addr1 The first IP address. + * \param addr2 The second IP address. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 +#define uip_ipaddr_cmp(addr1, addr2) ((addr1)->u16[0] == (addr2)->u16[0] && \ + (addr1)->u16[1] == (addr2)->u16[1]) +#else /* !UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +#define uip_ipaddr_cmp(addr1, addr2) (memcmp(addr1, addr2, sizeof(uip_ip6addr_t)) == 0) +#endif /* !UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +/** + * Compare two IP addresses with netmasks + * + * Compares two IP addresses with netmasks. The masks are used to mask + * out the bits that are to be compared. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr1, ipaddr2, mask; + + uip_ipaddr(&mask, 255,255,255,0); + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr1, 192,16,1,2); + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr2, 192,16,1,3); + if(uip_ipaddr_maskcmp(&ipaddr1, &ipaddr2, &mask)) { + printf("They are the same"); + } + \endcode + * + * \param addr1 The first IP address. + * \param addr2 The second IP address. + * \param mask The netmask. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 +#define uip_ipaddr_maskcmp(addr1, addr2, mask) \ + (((((u16_t *)addr1)[0] & ((u16_t *)mask)[0]) == \ + (((u16_t *)addr2)[0] & ((u16_t *)mask)[0])) && \ + ((((u16_t *)addr1)[1] & ((u16_t *)mask)[1]) == \ + (((u16_t *)addr2)[1] & ((u16_t *)mask)[1]))) +#else +#define uip_ipaddr_prefixcmp(addr1, addr2, length) (memcmp(addr1, addr2, length>>3) == 0) +#endif + + +/** + * Check if an address is a broadcast address for a network. + * + * Checks if an address is the broadcast address for a network. The + * network is defined by an IP address that is on the network and the + * network's netmask. + * + * \param addr The IP address. + * \param netaddr The network's IP address. + * \param netmask The network's netmask. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +/*#define uip_ipaddr_isbroadcast(addr, netaddr, netmask) + ((uip_ipaddr_t *)(addr)).u16 & ((uip_ipaddr_t *)(addr)).u16*/ + + + +/** + * Mask out the network part of an IP address. + * + * Masks out the network part of an IP address, given the address and + * the netmask. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr1, ipaddr2, netmask; + + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr1, 192,16,1,2); + uip_ipaddr(&netmask, 255,255,255,0); + uip_ipaddr_mask(&ipaddr2, &ipaddr1, &netmask); + \endcode + * + * In the example above, the variable "ipaddr2" will contain the IP + * address 192.168.1.0. + * + * \param dest Where the result is to be placed. + * \param src The IP address. + * \param mask The netmask. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_ipaddr_mask(dest, src, mask) do { \ + ((u16_t *)dest)[0] = ((u16_t *)src)[0] & ((u16_t *)mask)[0]; \ + ((u16_t *)dest)[1] = ((u16_t *)src)[1] & ((u16_t *)mask)[1]; \ + } while(0) + +/** + * Pick the first octet of an IP address. + * + * Picks out the first octet of an IP address. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr; + u8_t octet; + + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr, 1,2,3,4); + octet = uip_ipaddr1(&ipaddr); + \endcode + * + * In the example above, the variable "octet" will contain the value 1. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_ipaddr1(addr) ((addr)->u8[0]) + +/** + * Pick the second octet of an IP address. + * + * Picks out the second octet of an IP address. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr; + u8_t octet; + + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr, 1,2,3,4); + octet = uip_ipaddr2(&ipaddr); + \endcode + * + * In the example above, the variable "octet" will contain the value 2. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_ipaddr2(addr) ((addr)->u8[1]) + +/** + * Pick the third octet of an IP address. + * + * Picks out the third octet of an IP address. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr; + u8_t octet; + + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr, 1,2,3,4); + octet = uip_ipaddr3(&ipaddr); + \endcode + * + * In the example above, the variable "octet" will contain the value 3. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_ipaddr3(addr) ((addr)->u8[2]) + +/** + * Pick the fourth octet of an IP address. + * + * Picks out the fourth octet of an IP address. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr; + u8_t octet; + + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr, 1,2,3,4); + octet = uip_ipaddr4(&ipaddr); + \endcode + * + * In the example above, the variable "octet" will contain the value 4. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_ipaddr4(addr) ((addr)->u8[3]) + +/** + * Convert 16-bit quantity from host byte order to network byte order. + * + * This macro is primarily used for converting constants from host + * byte order to network byte order. For converting variables to + * network byte order, use the htons() function instead. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifndef HTONS +# if UIP_BYTE_ORDER == UIP_BIG_ENDIAN +# define HTONS(n) (n) +# define HTONL(n) (n) +# else /* UIP_BYTE_ORDER == UIP_BIG_ENDIAN */ +# define HTONS(n) (u16_t)((((u16_t) (n)) << 8) | (((u16_t) (n)) >> 8)) +# define HTONL(n) (((u32_t)HTONS(n) << 16) | HTONS((u32_t)(n) >> 16)) +# endif /* UIP_BYTE_ORDER == UIP_BIG_ENDIAN */ +#else +#error "HTONS already defined!" +#endif /* HTONS */ + +/** + * Convert 16-bit quantity from host byte order to network byte order. + * + * This function is primarily used for converting variables from host + * byte order to network byte order. For converting constants to + * network byte order, use the HTONS() macro instead. + */ +#ifndef htons +u16_t htons(u16_t val); +#endif /* htons */ +#ifndef ntohs +#define ntohs htons +#endif + +#ifndef htonl +u32_t htonl(u32_t val); +#endif /* htonl */ +#ifndef ntohl +#define ntohl htonl +#endif + +/** @} */ + +/** + * Pointer to the application data in the packet buffer. + * + * This pointer points to the application data when the application is + * called. If the application wishes to send data, the application may + * use this space to write the data into before calling uip_send(). + */ +extern void *uip_appdata; + +#if UIP_URGDATA > 0 +/* u8_t *uip_urgdata: + * + * This pointer points to any urgent data that has been received. Only + * present if compiled with support for urgent data (UIP_URGDATA). + */ +extern void *uip_urgdata; +#endif /* UIP_URGDATA > 0 */ + + +/** + * \defgroup uipdrivervars Variables used in uIP device drivers + * @{ + * + * uIP has a few global variables that are used in device drivers for + * uIP. + */ + +/** + * The length of the packet in the uip_buf buffer. + * + * The global variable uip_len holds the length of the packet in the + * uip_buf buffer. + * + * When the network device driver calls the uIP input function, + * uip_len should be set to the length of the packet in the uip_buf + * buffer. + * + * When sending packets, the device driver should use the contents of + * the uip_len variable to determine the length of the outgoing + * packet. + * + */ +extern u16_t uip_len; + +/** + * The length of the extension headers + */ +extern u8_t uip_ext_len; +/** @} */ + +#if UIP_URGDATA > 0 +extern u16_t uip_urglen, uip_surglen; +#endif /* UIP_URGDATA > 0 */ + + +/** + * Representation of a uIP TCP connection. + * + * The uip_conn structure is used for identifying a connection. All + * but one field in the structure are to be considered read-only by an + * application. The only exception is the appstate field whose purpose + * is to let the application store application-specific state (e.g., + * file pointers) for the connection. The type of this field is + * configured in the "uipopt.h" header file. + */ +struct uip_conn { + uip_ipaddr_t ripaddr; /**< The IP address of the remote host. */ + + u16_t lport; /**< The local TCP port, in network byte order. */ + u16_t rport; /**< The local remote TCP port, in network byte + order. */ + + u8_t rcv_nxt[4]; /**< The sequence number that we expect to + receive next. */ + u8_t snd_nxt[4]; /**< The sequence number that was last sent by + us. */ + u16_t len; /**< Length of the data that was previously sent. */ + u16_t mss; /**< Current maximum segment size for the + connection. */ + u16_t initialmss; /**< Initial maximum segment size for the + connection. */ + u8_t sa; /**< Retransmission time-out calculation state + variable. */ + u8_t sv; /**< Retransmission time-out calculation state + variable. */ + u8_t rto; /**< Retransmission time-out. */ + u8_t tcpstateflags; /**< TCP state and flags. */ + u8_t timer; /**< The retransmission timer. */ + u8_t nrtx; /**< The number of retransmissions for the last + segment sent. */ + + /** The application state. */ + uip_tcp_appstate_t appstate; +}; + + +/** + * Pointer to the current TCP connection. + * + * The uip_conn pointer can be used to access the current TCP + * connection. + */ + +extern struct uip_conn *uip_conn; +#if UIP_TCP +/* The array containing all uIP connections. */ +extern struct uip_conn uip_conns[UIP_CONNS]; +#endif + +/** + * \addtogroup uiparch + * @{ + */ + +/** + * 4-byte array used for the 32-bit sequence number calculations. + */ +extern u8_t uip_acc32[4]; +/** @} */ + +/** + * Representation of a uIP UDP connection. + */ +struct uip_udp_conn { + uip_ipaddr_t ripaddr; /**< The IP address of the remote peer. */ + u16_t lport; /**< The local port number in network byte order. */ + u16_t rport; /**< The remote port number in network byte order. */ + u8_t ttl; /**< Default time-to-live. */ + + /** The application state. */ + uip_udp_appstate_t appstate; +}; + +/** + * The current UDP connection. + */ +extern struct uip_udp_conn *uip_udp_conn; +extern struct uip_udp_conn uip_udp_conns[UIP_UDP_CONNS]; + +struct uip_router { + int (*activate)(void); + int (*deactivate)(void); + uip_ipaddr_t *(*lookup)(uip_ipaddr_t *destipaddr, uip_ipaddr_t *nexthop); +}; + +#if UIP_CONF_ROUTER +extern const struct uip_router *uip_router; + +/** + * uIP routing driver registration function. + */ +void uip_router_register(const struct uip_router *router); +#endif /*UIP_CONF_ROUTER*/ + +#if UIP_CONF_ICMP6 +struct uip_icmp6_conn { + uip_icmp6_appstate_t appstate; +}; +extern struct uip_icmp6_conn uip_icmp6_conns; +#endif /*UIP_CONF_ICMP6*/ + +/** + * The uIP TCP/IP statistics. + * + * This is the variable in which the uIP TCP/IP statistics are gathered. + */ +#if UIP_STATISTICS == 1 +extern struct uip_stats uip_stat; +#define UIP_STAT(s) s +#else +#define UIP_STAT(s) +#endif /* UIP_STATISTICS == 1 */ + +/** + * The structure holding the TCP/IP statistics that are gathered if + * UIP_STATISTICS is set to 1. + * + */ +struct uip_stats { + struct { + uip_stats_t recv; /**< Number of received packets at the IP + layer. */ + uip_stats_t sent; /**< Number of sent packets at the IP + layer. */ + uip_stats_t forwarded;/**< Number of forwarded packets at the IP + layer. */ + uip_stats_t drop; /**< Number of dropped packets at the IP + layer. */ + uip_stats_t vhlerr; /**< Number of packets dropped due to wrong + IP version or header length. */ + uip_stats_t hblenerr; /**< Number of packets dropped due to wrong + IP length, high byte. */ + uip_stats_t lblenerr; /**< Number of packets dropped due to wrong + IP length, low byte. */ + uip_stats_t fragerr; /**< Number of packets dropped since they + were IP fragments. */ + uip_stats_t chkerr; /**< Number of packets dropped due to IP + checksum errors. */ + uip_stats_t protoerr; /**< Number of packets dropped since they + were neither ICMP, UDP nor TCP. */ + } ip; /**< IP statistics. */ + struct { + uip_stats_t recv; /**< Number of received ICMP packets. */ + uip_stats_t sent; /**< Number of sent ICMP packets. */ + uip_stats_t drop; /**< Number of dropped ICMP packets. */ + uip_stats_t typeerr; /**< Number of ICMP packets with a wrong + type. */ + uip_stats_t chkerr; /**< Number of ICMP packets with a bad + checksum. */ + } icmp; /**< ICMP statistics. */ +#if UIP_TCP + struct { + uip_stats_t recv; /**< Number of received TCP segments. */ + uip_stats_t sent; /**< Number of sent TCP segments. */ + uip_stats_t drop; /**< Number of dropped TCP segments. */ + uip_stats_t chkerr; /**< Number of TCP segments with a bad + checksum. */ + uip_stats_t ackerr; /**< Number of TCP segments with a bad ACK + number. */ + uip_stats_t rst; /**< Number of received TCP RST (reset) segments. */ + uip_stats_t rexmit; /**< Number of retransmitted TCP segments. */ + uip_stats_t syndrop; /**< Number of dropped SYNs due to too few + connections was available. */ + uip_stats_t synrst; /**< Number of SYNs for closed ports, + triggering a RST. */ + } tcp; /**< TCP statistics. */ +#endif +#if UIP_UDP + struct { + uip_stats_t drop; /**< Number of dropped UDP segments. */ + uip_stats_t recv; /**< Number of received UDP segments. */ + uip_stats_t sent; /**< Number of sent UDP segments. */ + uip_stats_t chkerr; /**< Number of UDP segments with a bad + checksum. */ + } udp; /**< UDP statistics. */ +#endif /* UIP_UDP */ +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 + struct { + uip_stats_t drop; /**< Number of dropped ND6 packets. */ + uip_stats_t recv; /**< Number of received ND6 packets */ + uip_stats_t sent; /**< Number of sent ND6 packets */ + } nd6; +#endif /*UIP_CONF_IPV6*/ +}; + + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* All the stuff below this point is internal to uIP and should not be + * used directly by an application or by a device driver. + */ +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + + + +/* u8_t uip_flags: + * + * When the application is called, uip_flags will contain the flags + * that are defined in this file. Please read below for more + * information. + */ +extern u8_t uip_flags; + +/* The following flags may be set in the global variable uip_flags + before calling the application callback. The UIP_ACKDATA, + UIP_NEWDATA, and UIP_CLOSE flags may both be set at the same time, + whereas the others are mutually exclusive. Note that these flags + should *NOT* be accessed directly, but only through the uIP + functions/macros. */ + +#define UIP_ACKDATA 1 /* Signifies that the outstanding data was + acked and the application should send + out new data instead of retransmitting + the last data. */ +#define UIP_NEWDATA 2 /* Flags the fact that the peer has sent + us new data. */ +#define UIP_REXMIT 4 /* Tells the application to retransmit the + data that was last sent. */ +#define UIP_POLL 8 /* Used for polling the application, to + check if the application has data that + it wants to send. */ +#define UIP_CLOSE 16 /* The remote host has closed the + connection, thus the connection has + gone away. Or the application signals + that it wants to close the + connection. */ +#define UIP_ABORT 32 /* The remote host has aborted the + connection, thus the connection has + gone away. Or the application signals + that it wants to abort the + connection. */ +#define UIP_CONNECTED 64 /* We have got a connection from a remote + host and have set up a new connection + for it, or an active connection has + been successfully established. */ + +#define UIP_TIMEDOUT 128 /* The connection has been aborted due to + too many retransmissions. */ + + +/** + * \brief process the options within a hop by hop or destination option header + * \retval 0: nothing to send, + * \retval 1: drop pkt + * \retval 2: ICMP error message to send +*/ +/*static u8_t +uip_ext_hdr_options_process(); */ + +/* uip_process(flag): + * + * The actual uIP function which does all the work. + */ +void uip_process(u8_t flag); + + /* The following flags are passed as an argument to the uip_process() + function. They are used to distinguish between the two cases where + uip_process() is called. It can be called either because we have + incoming data that should be processed, or because the periodic + timer has fired. These values are never used directly, but only in + the macros defined in this file. */ + +#define UIP_DATA 1 /* Tells uIP that there is incoming + data in the uip_buf buffer. The + length of the data is stored in the + global variable uip_len. */ +#define UIP_TIMER 2 /* Tells uIP that the periodic timer + has fired. */ +#define UIP_POLL_REQUEST 3 /* Tells uIP that a connection should + be polled. */ +#define UIP_UDP_SEND_CONN 4 /* Tells uIP that a UDP datagram + should be constructed in the + uip_buf buffer. */ +#if UIP_UDP +#define UIP_UDP_TIMER 5 +#endif /* UIP_UDP */ + +/* The TCP states used in the uip_conn->tcpstateflags. */ +#define UIP_CLOSED 0 +#define UIP_SYN_RCVD 1 +#define UIP_SYN_SENT 2 +#define UIP_ESTABLISHED 3 +#define UIP_FIN_WAIT_1 4 +#define UIP_FIN_WAIT_2 5 +#define UIP_CLOSING 6 +#define UIP_TIME_WAIT 7 +#define UIP_LAST_ACK 8 +#define UIP_TS_MASK 15 + +#define UIP_STOPPED 16 + +/* The TCP and IP headers. */ +struct uip_tcpip_hdr { +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 + /* IPv6 header. */ + u8_t vtc, + tcflow; + u16_t flow; + u8_t len[2]; + u8_t proto, ttl; + uip_ip6addr_t srcipaddr, destipaddr; +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + /* IPv4 header. */ + u8_t vhl, + tos, + len[2], + ipid[2], + ipoffset[2], + ttl, + proto; + u16_t ipchksum; + uip_ipaddr_t srcipaddr, destipaddr; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + + /* TCP header. */ + u16_t srcport, + destport; + u8_t seqno[4], + ackno[4], + tcpoffset, + flags, + wnd[2]; + u16_t tcpchksum; + u8_t urgp[2]; + u8_t optdata[4]; +}; + +/* The ICMP and IP headers. */ +struct uip_icmpip_hdr { +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 + /* IPv6 header. */ + u8_t vtc, + tcf; + u16_t flow; + u8_t len[2]; + u8_t proto, ttl; + uip_ip6addr_t srcipaddr, destipaddr; +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + /* IPv4 header. */ + u8_t vhl, + tos, + len[2], + ipid[2], + ipoffset[2], + ttl, + proto; + u16_t ipchksum; + uip_ipaddr_t srcipaddr, destipaddr; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + + /* ICMP header. */ + u8_t type, icode; + u16_t icmpchksum; +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 + u16_t id, seqno; + u8_t payload[1]; +#endif /* !UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +}; + + +/* The UDP and IP headers. */ +struct uip_udpip_hdr { +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 + /* IPv6 header. */ + u8_t vtc, + tcf; + u16_t flow; + u8_t len[2]; + u8_t proto, ttl; + uip_ip6addr_t srcipaddr, destipaddr; +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + /* IP header. */ + u8_t vhl, + tos, + len[2], + ipid[2], + ipoffset[2], + ttl, + proto; + u16_t ipchksum; + uip_ipaddr_t srcipaddr, destipaddr; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + + /* UDP header. */ + u16_t srcport, + destport; + u16_t udplen; + u16_t udpchksum; +}; + +/* + * In IPv6 the length of the L3 headers before the transport header is + * not fixed, due to the possibility to include extension option headers + * after the IP header. hence we split here L3 and L4 headers + */ +/* The IP header */ +struct uip_ip_hdr { +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 + /* IPV6 header */ + u8_t vtc; + u8_t tcflow; + u16_t flow; + u8_t len[2]; + u8_t proto, ttl; + uip_ip6addr_t srcipaddr, destipaddr; +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + /* IPV4 header */ + u8_t vhl, + tos, + len[2], + ipid[2], + ipoffset[2], + ttl, + proto; + u16_t ipchksum; + uip_ipaddr_t srcipaddr, destipaddr; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +}; + + +/* + * IPv6 extension option headers: we are able to process + * the 4 extension headers defined in RFC2460 (IPv6): + * - Hop by hop option header, destination option header: + * These two are not used by any core IPv6 protocol, hence + * we just read them and go to the next. They convey options, + * the options defined in RFC2460 are Pad1 and PadN, which do + * some padding, and that we do not need to read (the length + * field in the header is enough) + * - Routing header: this one is most notably used by MIPv6, + * which we do not implement, hence we just read it and go + * to the next + * - Fragmentation header: we read this header and are able to + * reassemble packets + * + * We do not offer any means to send packets with extension headers + * + * We do not implement Authentication and ESP headers, which are + * used in IPSec and defined in RFC4302,4303,4305,4385 + */ +/* common header part */ +struct uip_ext_hdr { + u8_t next; + u8_t len; +}; + +/* Hop by Hop option header */ +struct uip_hbho_hdr { + u8_t next; + u8_t len; +}; + +/* destination option header */ +struct uip_desto_hdr { + u8_t next; + u8_t len; +}; + +/* We do not define structures for PAD1 and PADN options */ + +/* + * routing header + * the routing header as 4 common bytes, then routing header type + * specific data there are several types of routing header. Type 0 was + * deprecated as per RFC5095 most notable other type is 2, used in + * RFC3775 (MIPv6) here we do not implement MIPv6, so we just need to + * parse the 4 first bytes + */ +struct uip_routing_hdr { + u8_t next; + u8_t len; + u8_t routing_type; + u8_t seg_left; +}; + +/* fragmentation header */ +struct uip_frag_hdr { + u8_t next; + u8_t res; + u16_t offsetresmore; + u32_t id; +}; + +/* + * an option within the destination or hop by hop option headers + * it contains type an length, which is true for all options but PAD1 + */ +struct uip_ext_hdr_opt { + u8_t type; + u8_t len; +}; + +/* PADN option */ +struct uip_ext_hdr_opt_padn { + u8_t opt_type; + u8_t opt_len; +}; + +/* TCP header */ +struct uip_tcp_hdr { + u16_t srcport; + u16_t destport; + u8_t seqno[4]; + u8_t ackno[4]; + u8_t tcpoffset; + u8_t flags; + u8_t wnd[2]; + u16_t tcpchksum; + u8_t urgp[2]; + u8_t optdata[4]; +}; + +/* The ICMP headers. */ +struct uip_icmp_hdr { + u8_t type, icode; + u16_t icmpchksum; +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 + u16_t id, seqno; +#endif /* !UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +}; + + +/* The UDP headers. */ +struct uip_udp_hdr { + u16_t srcport; + u16_t destport; + u16_t udplen; + u16_t udpchksum; +}; + + +/** + * The buffer size available for user data in the \ref uip_buf buffer. + * + * This macro holds the available size for user data in the \ref + * uip_buf buffer. The macro is intended to be used for checking + * bounds of available user data. + * + * Example: + \code + snprintf(uip_appdata, UIP_APPDATA_SIZE, "%u\n", i); + \endcode + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define UIP_APPDATA_SIZE (UIP_BUFSIZE - UIP_LLH_LEN - UIP_TCPIP_HLEN) +#define UIP_APPDATA_PTR (void *)&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_TCPIP_HLEN] + +#define UIP_PROTO_ICMP 1 +#define UIP_PROTO_TCP 6 +#define UIP_PROTO_UDP 17 +#define UIP_PROTO_ICMP6 58 + + +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +/** @{ */ +/** \brief extension headers types */ +#define UIP_PROTO_HBHO 0 +#define UIP_PROTO_DESTO 60 +#define UIP_PROTO_ROUTING 43 +#define UIP_PROTO_FRAG 44 +#define UIP_PROTO_NONE 59 +/** @} */ + +/** @{ */ +/** \brief Destination and Hop By Hop extension headers option types */ +#define UIP_EXT_HDR_OPT_PAD1 0 +#define UIP_EXT_HDR_OPT_PADN 1 +/** @} */ + +/** @{ */ +/** + * \brief Bitmaps for extension header processing + * + * When processing extension headers, we should record somehow which one we + * see, because you cannot have twice the same header, except for destination + * We store all this in one u8_t bitmap one bit for each header expected. The + * order in the bitmap is the order recommended in RFC2460 + */ +#define UIP_EXT_HDR_BITMAP_HBHO 0x01 +#define UIP_EXT_HDR_BITMAP_DESTO1 0x02 +#define UIP_EXT_HDR_BITMAP_ROUTING 0x04 +#define UIP_EXT_HDR_BITMAP_FRAG 0x08 +#define UIP_EXT_HDR_BITMAP_AH 0x10 +#define UIP_EXT_HDR_BITMAP_ESP 0x20 +#define UIP_EXT_HDR_BITMAP_DESTO2 0x40 +/** @} */ + + +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + + +/* Header sizes. */ +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +#define UIP_IPH_LEN 40 +#define UIP_FRAGH_LEN 8 +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +#define UIP_IPH_LEN 20 /* Size of IP header */ +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +#define UIP_UDPH_LEN 8 /* Size of UDP header */ +#define UIP_TCPH_LEN 20 /* Size of TCP header */ +#ifdef UIP_IPH_LEN +#define UIP_ICMPH_LEN 4 /* Size of ICMP header */ +#endif +#define UIP_IPUDPH_LEN (UIP_UDPH_LEN + UIP_IPH_LEN) /* Size of IP + + * UDP + * header */ +#define UIP_IPTCPH_LEN (UIP_TCPH_LEN + UIP_IPH_LEN) /* Size of IP + + * TCP + * header */ +#define UIP_TCPIP_HLEN UIP_IPTCPH_LEN +#define UIP_IPICMPH_LEN (UIP_IPH_LEN + UIP_ICMPH_LEN) /* size of ICMP + + IP header */ +#define UIP_LLIPH_LEN (UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_IPH_LEN) /* size of L2 + + IP header */ +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +/** + * The sums below are quite used in ND. When used for uip_buf, we + * include link layer length when used for uip_len, we do not, hence + * we need values with and without LLH_LEN we do not use capital + * letters as these values are variable + */ +#define uip_l2_l3_hdr_len (UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_IPH_LEN + uip_ext_len) +#define uip_l2_l3_icmp_hdr_len (UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_IPH_LEN + uip_ext_len + UIP_ICMPH_LEN) +#define uip_l3_hdr_len (UIP_IPH_LEN + uip_ext_len) +#define uip_l3_icmp_hdr_len (UIP_IPH_LEN + uip_ext_len + UIP_ICMPH_LEN) +#endif /*UIP_CONF_IPV6*/ + + +#if UIP_FIXEDADDR +extern const uip_ipaddr_t uip_hostaddr, uip_netmask, uip_draddr; +#else /* UIP_FIXEDADDR */ +extern uip_ipaddr_t uip_hostaddr, uip_netmask, uip_draddr; +#endif /* UIP_FIXEDADDR */ +extern const uip_ipaddr_t uip_broadcast_addr; +extern const uip_ipaddr_t uip_all_zeroes_addr; + +#if UIP_FIXEDETHADDR +extern const uip_lladdr_t uip_lladdr; +#else +extern uip_lladdr_t uip_lladdr; +#endif + + + + +#ifdef UIP_CONF_IPV6 +/** + * \brief Is IPv6 address a the unspecified address + * a is of type uip_ipaddr_t + */ +#define uip_is_addr_unspecified(a) \ + ((((a)->u16[0]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[1]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[2]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[3]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[4]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[5]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[6]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[7]) == 0)) + +/** \brief Is IPv6 address a the link local all-nodes multicast address */ +#define uip_is_addr_linklocal_allnodes_mcast(a) \ + ((((a)->u8[0]) == 0xff) && \ + (((a)->u8[1]) == 0x02) && \ + (((a)->u16[1]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[2]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[3]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[4]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[5]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[6]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u8[14]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u8[15]) == 0x01)) + +/** \brief set IP address a to unspecified */ +#define uip_create_unspecified(a) uip_ip6addr(a, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0) + +/** \brief set IP address a to the link local all-nodes multicast address */ +#define uip_create_linklocal_allnodes_mcast(a) uip_ip6addr(a, 0xff02, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0x0001) + +/** \brief set IP address a to the link local all-routers multicast address */ +#define uip_create_linklocal_allrouters_mcast(a) uip_ip6addr(a, 0xff02, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0x0002) + +/** + * \brief is addr (a) a solicited node multicast address, see RFC3513 + * a is of type uip_ipaddr_t* + */ +#define uip_is_addr_solicited_node(a) \ + ((((a)->u8[0]) == 0xFF) && \ + (((a)->u8[1]) == 0x02) && \ + (((a)->u16[1]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[2]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[3]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[4]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[5]) == 1) && \ + (((a)->u8[12]) == 0xFF)) + +/** + * \briefput in b the solicited node address corresponding to address a + * both a and b are of type uip_ipaddr_t* + * */ +#define uip_create_solicited_node(a, b) \ + (((b)->u8[0]) = 0xFF); \ + (((b)->u8[1]) = 0x02); \ + (((b)->u16[1]) = 0); \ + (((b)->u16[2]) = 0); \ + (((b)->u16[3]) = 0); \ + (((b)->u16[4]) = 0); \ + (((b)->u8[10]) = 0); \ + (((b)->u8[11]) = 0x01); \ + (((b)->u8[12]) = 0xFF); \ + (((b)->u8[13]) = ((a)->u8[13])); \ + (((b)->u16[7]) = ((a)->u16[7])) + +/** + * \brief is addr (a) a link local unicast address, see RFC3513 + * i.e. is (a) on prefix FE80::/10 + * a is of type uip_ipaddr_t* + */ +#define uip_is_addr_link_local(a) \ + ((((a)->u8[0]) == 0xFE) && \ + (((a)->u8[1]) == 0x80)) + +/** + * \brief was addr (a) forged based on the mac address m + * a type is uip_ipaddr_t + * m type is uiplladdr_t + */ +#if UIP_CONF_LL_802154 +#define uip_is_addr_mac_addr_based(a, m) \ + ((((a)->u8[8]) == (((m)->addr[0]) ^ 0x02)) && \ + (((a)->u8[9]) == (m)->addr[1]) && \ + (((a)->u8[10]) == (m)->addr[2]) && \ + (((a)->u8[11]) == (m)->addr[3]) && \ + (((a)->u8[12]) == (m)->addr[4]) && \ + (((a)->u8[13]) == (m)->addr[5]) && \ + (((a)->u8[14]) == (m)->addr[6]) && \ + (((a)->u8[15]) == (m)->addr[7])) +#else + +#define uip_is_addr_mac_addr_based(a, m) \ + ((((a)->u8[8]) == (((m)->addr[0]) | 0x02)) && \ + (((a)->u8[9]) == (m)->addr[1]) && \ + (((a)->u8[10]) == (m)->addr[2]) && \ + (((a)->u8[11]) == 0xff) && \ + (((a)->u8[12]) == 0xfe) && \ + (((a)->u8[13]) == (m)->addr[3]) && \ + (((a)->u8[14]) == (m)->addr[4]) && \ + (((a)->u8[15]) == (m)->addr[5])) + +#endif /*UIP_CONF_LL_802154*/ + +/** + * \brief is address a multicast address, see RFC 3513 + * a is of type uip_ipaddr_t* + * */ +#define uip_is_addr_mcast(a) \ + (((a)->u8[0]) == 0xFF) + +/** + * \brief is group-id of multicast address a + * the all nodes group-id + */ +#define uip_is_mcast_group_id_all_nodes(a) \ + ((((a)->u16[1]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[2]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[3]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[4]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[5]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[6]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u8[14]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u8[15]) == 1)) + +/** + * \brief is group-id of multicast address a + * the all routers group-id + */ +#define uip_is_mcast_group_id_all_routers(a) \ + ((((a)->u16[1]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[2]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[3]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[4]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[5]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u16[6]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u8[14]) == 0) && \ + (((a)->u8[15]) == 2)) + + +#endif /*UIP_CONF_IPV6*/ + +/** + * Calculate the Internet checksum over a buffer. + * + * The Internet checksum is the one's complement of the one's + * complement sum of all 16-bit words in the buffer. + * + * See RFC1071. + * + * \param buf A pointer to the buffer over which the checksum is to be + * computed. + * + * \param len The length of the buffer over which the checksum is to + * be computed. + * + * \return The Internet checksum of the buffer. + */ +u16_t uip_chksum(u16_t *buf, u16_t len); + +/** + * Calculate the IP header checksum of the packet header in uip_buf. + * + * The IP header checksum is the Internet checksum of the 20 bytes of + * the IP header. + * + * \return The IP header checksum of the IP header in the uip_buf + * buffer. + */ +u16_t uip_ipchksum(void); + +/** + * Calculate the TCP checksum of the packet in uip_buf and uip_appdata. + * + * The TCP checksum is the Internet checksum of data contents of the + * TCP segment, and a pseudo-header as defined in RFC793. + * + * \return The TCP checksum of the TCP segment in uip_buf and pointed + * to by uip_appdata. + */ +u16_t uip_tcpchksum(void); + +/** + * Calculate the UDP checksum of the packet in uip_buf and uip_appdata. + * + * The UDP checksum is the Internet checksum of data contents of the + * UDP segment, and a pseudo-header as defined in RFC768. + * + * \return The UDP checksum of the UDP segment in uip_buf and pointed + * to by uip_appdata. + */ +u16_t uip_udpchksum(void); + +/** + * Calculate the ICMP checksum of the packet in uip_buf. + * + * \return The ICMP checksum of the ICMP packet in uip_buf + */ +u16_t uip_icmp6chksum(void); + + +#endif /* __UIP_H__ */ + + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip_arp.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip_arp.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fcb783b140 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip_arp.c @@ -0,0 +1,432 @@ +/** + * \addtogroup uip + * @{ + */ + +/** + * \defgroup uiparp uIP Address Resolution Protocol + * @{ + * + * The Address Resolution Protocol ARP is used for mapping between IP + * addresses and link level addresses such as the Ethernet MAC + * addresses. ARP uses broadcast queries to ask for the link level + * address of a known IP address and the host which is configured with + * the IP address for which the query was meant, will respond with its + * link level address. + * + * \note This ARP implementation only supports Ethernet. + */ + +/** + * \file + * Implementation of the ARP Address Resolution Protocol. + * \author Adam Dunkels <adam@dunkels.com> + * + */ + +/* + * Copyright (c) 2001-2003, Adam Dunkels. + * All rights reserved. + * + * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without + * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions + * are met: + * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright + * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. + * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright + * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the + * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. + * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote + * products derived from this software without specific prior + * written permission. + * + * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS + * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED + * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE + * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY + * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL + * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE + * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS + * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, + * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING + * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS + * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. + * + * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. + * + * $Id: uip_arp.c,v 1.5 2008/02/07 01:35:00 adamdunkels Exp $ + * + */ + + +#include "uip_arp.h" + +#include <string.h> + +struct arp_hdr { + struct uip_eth_hdr ethhdr; + u16_t hwtype; + u16_t protocol; + u8_t hwlen; + u8_t protolen; + u16_t opcode; + struct uip_eth_addr shwaddr; + uip_ipaddr_t sipaddr; + struct uip_eth_addr dhwaddr; + uip_ipaddr_t dipaddr; +}; + +struct ethip_hdr { + struct uip_eth_hdr ethhdr; + /* IP header. */ + u8_t vhl, + tos, + len[2], + ipid[2], + ipoffset[2], + ttl, + proto; + u16_t ipchksum; + uip_ipaddr_t srcipaddr, destipaddr; +}; + +#define ARP_REQUEST 1 +#define ARP_REPLY 2 + +#define ARP_HWTYPE_ETH 1 + +struct arp_entry { + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr; + struct uip_eth_addr ethaddr; + u8_t time; +}; + +static const struct uip_eth_addr broadcast_ethaddr = + {{0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff}}; +static const u16_t broadcast_ipaddr[2] = {0xffff,0xffff}; + +static struct arp_entry arp_table[UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE]; +static uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr; +static u8_t i, c; + +static u8_t arptime; +static u8_t tmpage; + +#define BUF ((struct arp_hdr *)&uip_buf[0]) +#define IPBUF ((struct ethip_hdr *)&uip_buf[0]) + +#define DEBUG 0 +#if DEBUG +#include <stdio.h> +#define PRINTF(...) printf(__VA_ARGS__) +#else +#define PRINTF(...) +#endif + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * Initialize the ARP module. + * + */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_arp_init(void) +{ + for(i = 0; i < UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE; ++i) { + memset(&arp_table[i].ipaddr, 0, 4); + } +} +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * Periodic ARP processing function. + * + * This function performs periodic timer processing in the ARP module + * and should be called at regular intervals. The recommended interval + * is 10 seconds between the calls. + * + */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_arp_timer(void) +{ + struct arp_entry *tabptr = NULL; + + ++arptime; + for(i = 0; i < UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE; ++i) { + tabptr = &arp_table[i]; + if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&tabptr->ipaddr, &uip_all_zeroes_addr) && + arptime - tabptr->time >= UIP_ARP_MAXAGE) { + memset(&tabptr->ipaddr, 0, 4); + } + } + +} +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +static void +uip_arp_update(uip_ipaddr_t *ipaddr, struct uip_eth_addr *ethaddr) +{ + register struct arp_entry *tabptr = NULL; + /* Walk through the ARP mapping table and try to find an entry to + update. If none is found, the IP -> MAC address mapping is + inserted in the ARP table. */ + for(i = 0; i < UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE; ++i) { + + tabptr = &arp_table[i]; + /* Only check those entries that are actually in use. */ + if(!uip_ipaddr_cmp(&tabptr->ipaddr, &uip_all_zeroes_addr)) { + + /* Check if the source IP address of the incoming packet matches + the IP address in this ARP table entry. */ + if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(ipaddr, &tabptr->ipaddr)) { + + /* An old entry found, update this and return. */ + memcpy(tabptr->ethaddr.addr, ethaddr->addr, 6); + tabptr->time = arptime; + + return; + } + } + } + + /* If we get here, no existing ARP table entry was found, so we + create one. */ + + /* First, we try to find an unused entry in the ARP table. */ + for(i = 0; i < UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE; ++i) { + tabptr = &arp_table[i]; + if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&tabptr->ipaddr, &uip_all_zeroes_addr)) { + break; + } + } + + /* If no unused entry is found, we try to find the oldest entry and + throw it away. */ + if(i == UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE) { + tmpage = 0; + c = 0; + for(i = 0; i < UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE; ++i) { + tabptr = &arp_table[i]; + if(arptime - tabptr->time > tmpage) { + tmpage = arptime - tabptr->time; + c = i; + } + } + i = c; + tabptr = &arp_table[i]; + } + + /* Now, i is the ARP table entry which we will fill with the new + information. */ + uip_ipaddr_copy(&tabptr->ipaddr, ipaddr); + memcpy(tabptr->ethaddr.addr, ethaddr->addr, 6); + tabptr->time = arptime; +} +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * ARP processing for incoming IP packets + * + * This function should be called by the device driver when an IP + * packet has been received. The function will check if the address is + * in the ARP cache, and if so the ARP cache entry will be + * refreshed. If no ARP cache entry was found, a new one is created. + * + * This function expects an IP packet with a prepended Ethernet header + * in the uip_buf[] buffer, and the length of the packet in the global + * variable uip_len. + */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if 0 +void +uip_arp_ipin(void) +{ + uip_len -= sizeof(struct uip_eth_hdr); + + /* Only insert/update an entry if the source IP address of the + incoming IP packet comes from a host on the local network. */ + if((IPBUF->srcipaddr[0] & uip_netmask[0]) != + (uip_hostaddr[0] & uip_netmask[0])) { + return; + } + if((IPBUF->srcipaddr[1] & uip_netmask[1]) != + (uip_hostaddr[1] & uip_netmask[1])) { + return; + } + uip_arp_update(IPBUF->srcipaddr, &(IPBUF->ethhdr.src)); + + return; +} +#endif /* 0 */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * ARP processing for incoming ARP packets. + * + * This function should be called by the device driver when an ARP + * packet has been received. The function will act differently + * depending on the ARP packet type: if it is a reply for a request + * that we previously sent out, the ARP cache will be filled in with + * the values from the ARP reply. If the incoming ARP packet is an ARP + * request for our IP address, an ARP reply packet is created and put + * into the uip_buf[] buffer. + * + * When the function returns, the value of the global variable uip_len + * indicates whether the device driver should send out a packet or + * not. If uip_len is zero, no packet should be sent. If uip_len is + * non-zero, it contains the length of the outbound packet that is + * present in the uip_buf[] buffer. + * + * This function expects an ARP packet with a prepended Ethernet + * header in the uip_buf[] buffer, and the length of the packet in the + * global variable uip_len. + */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_arp_arpin(void) +{ + if(uip_len < sizeof(struct arp_hdr)) { + uip_len = 0; + return; + } + uip_len = 0; + + switch(BUF->opcode) { + case HTONS(ARP_REQUEST): + /* ARP request. If it asked for our address, we send out a + reply. */ + /* if(BUF->dipaddr[0] == uip_hostaddr[0] && + BUF->dipaddr[1] == uip_hostaddr[1]) {*/ + PRINTF("uip_arp_arpin: request for %d.%d.%d.%d (we are %d.%d.%d.%d)\n", + BUF->dipaddr.u8[0], BUF->dipaddr.u8[1], + BUF->dipaddr.u8[2], BUF->dipaddr.u8[3], + uip_hostaddr.u8[0], uip_hostaddr.u8[1], + uip_hostaddr.u8[2], uip_hostaddr.u8[3]); + if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&BUF->dipaddr, &uip_hostaddr)) { + /* First, we register the one who made the request in our ARP + table, since it is likely that we will do more communication + with this host in the future. */ + uip_arp_update(&BUF->sipaddr, &BUF->shwaddr); + + BUF->opcode = HTONS(ARP_REPLY); + + memcpy(BUF->dhwaddr.addr, BUF->shwaddr.addr, 6); + memcpy(BUF->shwaddr.addr, uip_ethaddr.addr, 6); + memcpy(BUF->ethhdr.src.addr, uip_ethaddr.addr, 6); + memcpy(BUF->ethhdr.dest.addr, BUF->dhwaddr.addr, 6); + + uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->dipaddr, &BUF->sipaddr); + uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->sipaddr, &uip_hostaddr); + + BUF->ethhdr.type = HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_ARP); + uip_len = sizeof(struct arp_hdr); + } + break; + case HTONS(ARP_REPLY): + /* ARP reply. We insert or update the ARP table if it was meant + for us. */ + if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&BUF->dipaddr, &uip_hostaddr)) { + uip_arp_update(&BUF->sipaddr, &BUF->shwaddr); + } + break; + } + + return; +} +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * Prepend Ethernet header to an outbound IP packet and see if we need + * to send out an ARP request. + * + * This function should be called before sending out an IP packet. The + * function checks the destination IP address of the IP packet to see + * what Ethernet MAC address that should be used as a destination MAC + * address on the Ethernet. + * + * If the destination IP address is in the local network (determined + * by logical ANDing of netmask and our IP address), the function + * checks the ARP cache to see if an entry for the destination IP + * address is found. If so, an Ethernet header is prepended and the + * function returns. If no ARP cache entry is found for the + * destination IP address, the packet in the uip_buf[] is replaced by + * an ARP request packet for the IP address. The IP packet is dropped + * and it is assumed that they higher level protocols (e.g., TCP) + * eventually will retransmit the dropped packet. + * + * If the destination IP address is not on the local network, the IP + * address of the default router is used instead. + * + * When the function returns, a packet is present in the uip_buf[] + * buffer, and the length of the packet is in the global variable + * uip_len. + */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_arp_out(void) +{ + struct arp_entry *tabptr = NULL; + + /* Find the destination IP address in the ARP table and construct + the Ethernet header. If the destination IP address isn't on the + local network, we use the default router's IP address instead. + + If not ARP table entry is found, we overwrite the original IP + packet with an ARP request for the IP address. */ + + /* First check if destination is a local broadcast. */ + if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&IPBUF->destipaddr, &uip_broadcast_addr)) { + memcpy(IPBUF->ethhdr.dest.addr, broadcast_ethaddr.addr, 6); + } else { + /* Check if the destination address is on the local network. */ + if(!uip_ipaddr_maskcmp(&IPBUF->destipaddr, &uip_hostaddr, &uip_netmask)) { + /* Destination address was not on the local network, so we need to + use the default router's IP address instead of the destination + address when determining the MAC address. */ + uip_ipaddr_copy(&ipaddr, &uip_draddr); + } else { + /* Else, we use the destination IP address. */ + uip_ipaddr_copy(&ipaddr, &IPBUF->destipaddr); + } + + for(i = 0; i < UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE; ++i) { + tabptr = &arp_table[i]; + if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&ipaddr, &tabptr->ipaddr)) { + break; + } + } + + if(i == UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE) { + /* The destination address was not in our ARP table, so we + overwrite the IP packet with an ARP request. */ + + memset(BUF->ethhdr.dest.addr, 0xff, 6); + memset(BUF->dhwaddr.addr, 0x00, 6); + memcpy(BUF->ethhdr.src.addr, uip_ethaddr.addr, 6); + memcpy(BUF->shwaddr.addr, uip_ethaddr.addr, 6); + + uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->dipaddr, &ipaddr); + uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->sipaddr, &uip_hostaddr); + BUF->opcode = HTONS(ARP_REQUEST); /* ARP request. */ + BUF->hwtype = HTONS(ARP_HWTYPE_ETH); + BUF->protocol = HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_IP); + BUF->hwlen = 6; + BUF->protolen = 4; + BUF->ethhdr.type = HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_ARP); + + uip_appdata = &uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN]; + + uip_len = sizeof(struct arp_hdr); + return; + } + + /* Build an ethernet header. */ + memcpy(IPBUF->ethhdr.dest.addr, tabptr->ethaddr.addr, 6); + } + memcpy(IPBUF->ethhdr.src.addr, uip_ethaddr.addr, 6); + + IPBUF->ethhdr.type = HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_IP); + + uip_len += sizeof(struct uip_eth_hdr); +} +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +/** @} */ +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip_arp.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip_arp.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4e78ce7b77 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip_arp.h @@ -0,0 +1,146 @@ +/** + * \addtogroup uip + * @{ + */ + +/** + * \addtogroup uiparp + * @{ + */ + +/** + * \file + * Macros and definitions for the ARP module. + * \author Adam Dunkels <adam@dunkels.com> + */ + + +/* + * Copyright (c) 2001-2003, Adam Dunkels. + * All rights reserved. + * + * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without + * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions + * are met: + * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright + * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. + * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright + * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the + * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. + * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote + * products derived from this software without specific prior + * written permission. + * + * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS + * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED + * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE + * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY + * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL + * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE + * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS + * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, + * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING + * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS + * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. + * + * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. + * + * $Id: uip_arp.h,v 1.2 2006/08/26 23:58:45 oliverschmidt Exp $ + * + */ + +#ifndef __UIP_ARP_H__ +#define __UIP_ARP_H__ + +#include "uip.h" + + +extern struct uip_eth_addr uip_ethaddr; + +/** + * The Ethernet header. + */ +struct uip_eth_hdr { + struct uip_eth_addr dest; + struct uip_eth_addr src; + u16_t type; +}; + +#define UIP_ETHTYPE_ARP 0x0806 +#define UIP_ETHTYPE_IP 0x0800 +#define UIP_ETHTYPE_IPV6 0x86dd + + +/* The uip_arp_init() function must be called before any of the other + ARP functions. */ +void uip_arp_init(void); + +/* The uip_arp_ipin() function should be called whenever an IP packet + arrives from the Ethernet. This function refreshes the ARP table or + inserts a new mapping if none exists. The function assumes that an + IP packet with an Ethernet header is present in the uip_buf buffer + and that the length of the packet is in the uip_len variable. */ +/*void uip_arp_ipin(void);*/ +#define uip_arp_ipin() + +/* The uip_arp_arpin() should be called when an ARP packet is received + by the Ethernet driver. This function also assumes that the + Ethernet frame is present in the uip_buf buffer. When the + uip_arp_arpin() function returns, the contents of the uip_buf + buffer should be sent out on the Ethernet if the uip_len variable + is > 0. */ +void uip_arp_arpin(void); + +/* The uip_arp_out() function should be called when an IP packet + should be sent out on the Ethernet. This function creates an + Ethernet header before the IP header in the uip_buf buffer. The + Ethernet header will have the correct Ethernet MAC destination + address filled in if an ARP table entry for the destination IP + address (or the IP address of the default router) is present. If no + such table entry is found, the IP packet is overwritten with an ARP + request and we rely on TCP to retransmit the packet that was + overwritten. In any case, the uip_len variable holds the length of + the Ethernet frame that should be transmitted. */ +void uip_arp_out(void); + +/* The uip_arp_timer() function should be called every ten seconds. It + is responsible for flushing old entries in the ARP table. */ +void uip_arp_timer(void); + +/** @} */ + +/** + * \addtogroup uipconffunc + * @{ + */ + + +/** + * Specifiy the Ethernet MAC address. + * + * The ARP code needs to know the MAC address of the Ethernet card in + * order to be able to respond to ARP queries and to generate working + * Ethernet headers. + * + * \note This macro only specifies the Ethernet MAC address to the ARP + * code. It cannot be used to change the MAC address of the Ethernet + * card. + * + * \param eaddr A pointer to a struct uip_eth_addr containing the + * Ethernet MAC address of the Ethernet card. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_setethaddr(eaddr) do {uip_ethaddr.addr[0] = eaddr.addr[0]; \ + uip_ethaddr.addr[1] = eaddr.addr[1];\ + uip_ethaddr.addr[2] = eaddr.addr[2];\ + uip_ethaddr.addr[3] = eaddr.addr[3];\ + uip_ethaddr.addr[4] = eaddr.addr[4];\ + uip_ethaddr.addr[5] = eaddr.addr[5];} while(0) + +/** @} */ + + +#endif /* __UIP_ARP_H__ */ +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uipopt.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uipopt.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..520c03f25e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uipopt.h @@ -0,0 +1,740 @@ +/** + * \addtogroup uip + * @{ + */ + +/** + * \defgroup uipopt Configuration options for uIP + * @{ + * + * uIP is configured using the per-project configuration file + * "uipopt.h". This file contains all compile-time options for uIP and + * should be tweaked to match each specific project. The uIP + * distribution contains a documented example "uipopt.h" that can be + * copied and modified for each project. + */ + +/** + * \file + * Configuration options for uIP. + * \author Adam Dunkels <adam@dunkels.com> + * + * This file is used for tweaking various configuration options for + * uIP. You should make a copy of this file into one of your project's + * directories instead of editing this example "uipopt.h" file that + * comes with the uIP distribution. + */ + +/* + * Copyright (c) 2001-2003, Adam Dunkels. + * All rights reserved. + * + * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without + * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions + * are met: + * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright + * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. + * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright + * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the + * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. + * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote + * products derived from this software without specific prior + * written permission. + * + * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS + * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED + * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE + * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY + * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL + * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE + * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS + * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, + * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING + * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS + * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. + * + * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. + * + * $Id: uipopt.h,v 1.11 2009/04/10 00:37:48 adamdunkels Exp $ + * + */ + +#ifndef __UIPOPT_H__ +#define __UIPOPT_H__ + +#include "Config/AppConfig.h" + +#ifndef UIP_LITTLE_ENDIAN +#define UIP_LITTLE_ENDIAN 3412 +#endif /* UIP_LITTLE_ENDIAN */ +#ifndef UIP_BIG_ENDIAN +#define UIP_BIG_ENDIAN 1234 +#endif /* UIP_BIG_ENDIAN */ + +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +/** + * \defgroup uipoptstaticconf Static configuration options + * @{ + * + * These configuration options can be used for setting the IP address + * settings statically, but only if UIP_FIXEDADDR is set to 1. The + * configuration options for a specific node includes IP address, + * netmask and default router as well as the Ethernet address. The + * netmask, default router and Ethernet address are applicable only + * if uIP should be run over Ethernet. + * + * This options are meaningful only for the IPv4 code. + * + * All of these should be changed to suit your project. + */ + +/** + * Determines if uIP should use a fixed IP address or not. + * + * If uIP should use a fixed IP address, the settings are set in the + * uipopt.h file. If not, the macros uip_sethostaddr(), + * uip_setdraddr() and uip_setnetmask() should be used instead. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define UIP_FIXEDADDR 0 + +/** + * Ping IP address assignment. + * + * uIP uses a "ping" packets for setting its own IP address if this + * option is set. If so, uIP will start with an empty IP address and + * the destination IP address of the first incoming "ping" (ICMP echo) + * packet will be used for setting the hosts IP address. + * + * \note This works only if UIP_FIXEDADDR is 0. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_PINGADDRCONF +#define UIP_PINGADDRCONF UIP_CONF_PINGADDRCONF +#else /* UIP_CONF_PINGADDRCONF */ +#define UIP_PINGADDRCONF 0 +#endif /* UIP_CONF_PINGADDRCONF */ + + +/** + * Specifies if the uIP ARP module should be compiled with a fixed + * Ethernet MAC address or not. + * + * If this configuration option is 0, the macro uip_setethaddr() can + * be used to specify the Ethernet address at run-time. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define UIP_FIXEDETHADDR 0 + +/** @} */ +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * \defgroup uipoptip IP configuration options + * @{ + * + */ +/** + * The IP TTL (time to live) of IP packets sent by uIP. + * + * This should normally not be changed. + */ +#define UIP_TTL 64 + +/** + * The maximum time an IP fragment should wait in the reassembly + * buffer before it is dropped. + * + */ +#define UIP_REASS_MAXAGE 60 /*60s*/ + +/** + * Turn on support for IP packet reassembly. + * + * uIP supports reassembly of fragmented IP packets. This features + * requires an additional amount of RAM to hold the reassembly buffer + * and the reassembly code size is approximately 700 bytes. The + * reassembly buffer is of the same size as the uip_buf buffer + * (configured by UIP_BUFSIZE). + * + * \note IP packet reassembly is not heavily tested. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_REASSEMBLY +#define UIP_REASSEMBLY UIP_CONF_REASSEMBLY +#else /* UIP_CONF_REASSEMBLY */ +#define UIP_REASSEMBLY 0 +#endif /* UIP_CONF_REASSEMBLY */ +/** @} */ + +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * \defgroup uipoptipv6 IPv6 configuration options + * @{ + * + */ + +/** The maximum transmission unit at the IP Layer*/ +#define UIP_LINK_MTU 1280 + +#ifndef UIP_CONF_IPV6 +/** Do we use IPv6 or not (default: no) */ +#define UIP_CONF_IPV6 0 +#endif + +#ifndef UIP_CONF_IPV6_QUEUE_PKT +/** Do we do per %neighbor queuing during address resolution (default: no) */ +#define UIP_CONF_IPV6_QUEUE_PKT 0 +#endif + +#ifndef UIP_CONF_IPV6_CHECKS +/** Do we do IPv6 consistency checks (highly recommended, default: yes) */ +#define UIP_CONF_IPV6_CHECKS 1 +#endif + +#ifndef UIP_CONF_IPV6_REASSEMBLY +/** Do we do IPv6 fragmentation (default: no) */ +#define UIP_CONF_IPV6_REASSEMBLY 0 +#endif + +#ifndef UIP_CONF_NETIF_MAX_ADDRESSES +/** Default number of IPv6 addresses associated to the node's interface */ +#define UIP_CONF_NETIF_MAX_ADDRESSES 3 +#endif + +#ifndef UIP_CONF_ND6_MAX_PREFIXES +/** Default number of IPv6 prefixes associated to the node's interface */ +#define UIP_CONF_ND6_MAX_PREFIXES 3 +#endif + +#ifndef UIP_CONF_ND6_MAX_NEIGHBORS +/** Default number of neighbors that can be stored in the %neighbor cache */ +#define UIP_CONF_ND6_MAX_NEIGHBORS 4 +#endif + +#ifndef UIP_CONF_ND6_MAX_DEFROUTERS +/** Minimum number of default routers */ +#define UIP_CONF_ND6_MAX_DEFROUTERS 2 +#endif +/** @} */ + +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * \defgroup uipoptudp UDP configuration options + * @{ + * + * \note The UDP support in uIP is still not entirely complete; there + * is no support for sending or receiving broadcast or multicast + * packets, but it works well enough to support a number of vital + * applications such as DNS queries, though + */ + +/** + * Toggles whether UDP support should be compiled in or not. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_UDP +#define UIP_UDP UIP_CONF_UDP +#else /* UIP_CONF_UDP */ +#define UIP_UDP 1 +#endif /* UIP_CONF_UDP */ + +/** + * Toggles if UDP checksums should be used or not. + * + * \note Support for UDP checksums is currently not included in uIP, + * so this option has no function. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_UDP_CHECKSUMS +#define UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS UIP_CONF_UDP_CHECKSUMS +#else +#define UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS 0 +#endif + +/** + * The maximum amount of concurrent UDP connections. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_UDP_CONNS +#define UIP_UDP_CONNS UIP_CONF_UDP_CONNS +#else /* UIP_CONF_UDP_CONNS */ +#define UIP_UDP_CONNS 10 +#endif /* UIP_CONF_UDP_CONNS */ + +/** + * The name of the function that should be called when UDP datagrams arrive. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ + + +/** @} */ +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * \defgroup uipopttcp TCP configuration options + * @{ + */ + +/** + * Toggles whether TCP support should be compiled in or not. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_TCP +#define UIP_TCP UIP_CONF_TCP +#else /* UIP_CONF_TCP */ +#define UIP_TCP 1 +#endif /* UIP_CONF_TCP */ + +/** + * Determines if support for opening connections from uIP should be + * compiled in. + * + * If the applications that are running on top of uIP for this project + * do not need to open outgoing TCP connections, this configuration + * option can be turned off to reduce the code size of uIP. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifndef UIP_CONF_ACTIVE_OPEN +#define UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN 1 +#else /* UIP_CONF_ACTIVE_OPEN */ +#define UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN UIP_CONF_ACTIVE_OPEN +#endif /* UIP_CONF_ACTIVE_OPEN */ + +/** + * The maximum number of simultaneously open TCP connections. + * + * Since the TCP connections are statically allocated, turning this + * configuration knob down results in less RAM used. Each TCP + * connection requires approximately 30 bytes of memory. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifndef UIP_CONF_MAX_CONNECTIONS +#define UIP_CONNS 10 +#else /* UIP_CONF_MAX_CONNECTIONS */ +#define UIP_CONNS UIP_CONF_MAX_CONNECTIONS +#endif /* UIP_CONF_MAX_CONNECTIONS */ + + +/** + * The maximum number of simultaneously listening TCP ports. + * + * Each listening TCP port requires 2 bytes of memory. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifndef UIP_CONF_MAX_LISTENPORTS +#define UIP_LISTENPORTS 20 +#else /* UIP_CONF_MAX_LISTENPORTS */ +#define UIP_LISTENPORTS UIP_CONF_MAX_LISTENPORTS +#endif /* UIP_CONF_MAX_LISTENPORTS */ + +/** + * Determines if support for TCP urgent data notification should be + * compiled in. + * + * Urgent data (out-of-band data) is a rarely used TCP feature that + * very seldom would be required. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#if !defined(UIP_URGDATA) +#define UIP_URGDATA 0 +#endif + +/** + * The initial retransmission timeout counted in timer pulses. + * + * This should not be changed. + */ +#if !defined(UIP_RTO) +#define UIP_RTO 3 +#endif + +/** + * The maximum number of times a segment should be retransmitted + * before the connection should be aborted. + * + * This should not be changed. + */ +#if !defined(UIP_MAXRTX) +#define UIP_MAXRTX 8 +#endif + +/** + * The maximum number of times a SYN segment should be retransmitted + * before a connection request should be deemed to have been + * unsuccessful. + * + * This should not need to be changed. + */ +#if !defined(UIP_MAXSYNRTX) +#define UIP_MAXSYNRTX 5 +#endif + +/** + * The TCP maximum segment size. + * + * This is should not be to set to more than + * UIP_BUFSIZE - UIP_LLH_LEN - UIP_TCPIP_HLEN. + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_TCP_MSS +#define UIP_TCP_MSS UIP_CONF_TCP_MSS +#else +#define UIP_TCP_MSS (UIP_BUFSIZE - UIP_LLH_LEN - UIP_TCPIP_HLEN) +#endif + +/** + * The size of the advertised receiver's window. + * + * Should be set low (i.e., to the size of the uip_buf buffer) if the + * application is slow to process incoming data, or high (32768 bytes) + * if the application processes data quickly. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifndef UIP_CONF_RECEIVE_WINDOW +#define UIP_RECEIVE_WINDOW UIP_TCP_MSS +#else +#define UIP_RECEIVE_WINDOW UIP_CONF_RECEIVE_WINDOW +#endif + +/** + * How long a connection should stay in the TIME_WAIT state. + * + * This configuration option has no real implication, and it should be + * left untouched. + */ +#define UIP_TIME_WAIT_TIMEOUT 120 + + +/** @} */ +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * \defgroup uipoptarp ARP configuration options + * @{ + */ + +/** + * The size of the ARP table. + * + * This option should be set to a larger value if this uIP node will + * have many connections from the local network. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_ARPTAB_SIZE +#define UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE UIP_CONF_ARPTAB_SIZE +#else +#define UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE 8 +#endif + +/** + * The maximum age of ARP table entries measured in 10ths of seconds. + * + * An UIP_ARP_MAXAGE of 120 corresponds to 20 minutes (BSD + * default). + */ +#define UIP_ARP_MAXAGE 120 + + +/** @} */ + +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +/** + * \defgroup uipoptmac layer 2 options (for ipv6) + * @{ + */ + +#define UIP_DEFAULT_PREFIX_LEN 64 + +/** @} */ + +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +/** + * \defgroup uipoptsics 6lowpan options (for ipv6) + * @{ + */ +/** + * Timeout for packet reassembly at the 6lowpan layer + * (should be < 60s) + */ +#ifdef SICSLOWPAN_CONF_MAXAGE +#define SICSLOWPAN_REASS_MAXAGE SICSLOWPAN_CONF_MAXAGE +#else +#define SICSLOWPAN_REASS_MAXAGE 20 +#endif + +/** + * Do we compress the IP header or not (default: no) + */ +#ifndef SICSLOWPAN_CONF_COMPRESSION +#define SICSLOWPAN_CONF_COMPRESSION 0 +#endif + +/** + * If we use IPHC compression, how many address contexts do we support + */ +#ifndef SICSLOWPAN_CONF_MAX_ADDR_CONTEXTS +#define SICSLOWPAN_CONF_MAX_ADDR_CONTEXTS 1 +#endif + +/** + * Do we support 6lowpan fragmentation + */ +#ifndef SICSLOWPAN_CONF_FRAG +#define SICSLOWPAN_CONF_FRAG 0 +#endif + +/** @} */ + +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +/** + * \defgroup uipoptgeneral General configuration options + * @{ + */ + +/** + * The size of the uIP packet buffer. + * + * The uIP packet buffer should not be smaller than 60 bytes, and does + * not need to be larger than 1514 bytes. Lower size results in lower + * TCP throughput, larger size results in higher TCP throughput. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifndef UIP_CONF_BUFFER_SIZE +#define UIP_BUFSIZE UIP_LINK_MTU + UIP_LLH_LEN +#else /* UIP_CONF_BUFFER_SIZE */ +#define UIP_BUFSIZE UIP_CONF_BUFFER_SIZE +#endif /* UIP_CONF_BUFFER_SIZE */ + + +/** + * Determines if statistics support should be compiled in. + * + * The statistics is useful for debugging and to show the user. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifndef UIP_CONF_STATISTICS +#define UIP_STATISTICS 0 +#else /* UIP_CONF_STATISTICS */ +#define UIP_STATISTICS UIP_CONF_STATISTICS +#endif /* UIP_CONF_STATISTICS */ + +/** + * Determines if logging of certain events should be compiled in. + * + * This is useful mostly for debugging. The function uip_log() + * must be implemented to suit the architecture of the project, if + * logging is turned on. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifndef UIP_CONF_LOGGING +#define UIP_LOGGING 0 +#else /* UIP_CONF_LOGGING */ +#define UIP_LOGGING UIP_CONF_LOGGING +#endif /* UIP_CONF_LOGGING */ + +/** + * Broadcast support. + * + * This flag configures IP broadcast support. This is useful only + * together with UDP. + * + * \hideinitializer + * + */ +#ifndef UIP_CONF_BROADCAST +#define UIP_BROADCAST 0 +#else /* UIP_CONF_BROADCAST */ +#define UIP_BROADCAST UIP_CONF_BROADCAST +#endif /* UIP_CONF_BROADCAST */ + +/** + * Print out a uIP log message. + * + * This function must be implemented by the module that uses uIP, and + * is called by uIP whenever a log message is generated. + */ +void uip_log(char *msg); + +/** + * The link level header length. + * + * This is the offset into the uip_buf where the IP header can be + * found. For Ethernet, this should be set to 14. For SLIP, this + * should be set to 0. + * + * \note we probably won't use this constant for other link layers than + * ethernet as they have variable header length (this is due to variable + * number and type of address fields and to optional security features) + * E.g.: 802.15.4 -> 2 + (1/2*4/8) + 0/5/6/10/14 + * 802.11 -> 4 + (6*3/4) + 2 + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_LLH_LEN +#define UIP_LLH_LEN UIP_CONF_LLH_LEN +#else /* UIP_LLH_LEN */ +#define UIP_LLH_LEN 14 +#endif /* UIP_CONF_LLH_LEN */ + +/** @} */ +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * \defgroup uipoptcpu CPU architecture configuration + * @{ + * + * The CPU architecture configuration is where the endianess of the + * CPU on which uIP is to be run is specified. Most CPUs today are + * little endian, and the most notable exception are the Motorolas + * which are big endian. The BYTE_ORDER macro should be changed to + * reflect the CPU architecture on which uIP is to be run. + */ + +/** + * The byte order of the CPU architecture on which uIP is to be run. + * + * This option can be either UIP_BIG_ENDIAN (Motorola byte order) or + * UIP_LITTLE_ENDIAN (Intel byte order). + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_BYTE_ORDER +#define UIP_BYTE_ORDER UIP_CONF_BYTE_ORDER +#else /* UIP_CONF_BYTE_ORDER */ +#define UIP_BYTE_ORDER UIP_LITTLE_ENDIAN +#endif /* UIP_CONF_BYTE_ORDER */ + +/** @} */ +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#include <ff.h> +#include <stdbool.h> +#include <stdint.h> + +#include "timer.h" + +typedef uint8_t u8_t; +typedef uint16_t u16_t; +typedef uint32_t u32_t; +typedef uint32_t uip_stats_t; + +/** + * \defgroup uipoptapp Application specific configurations + * @{ + * + * An uIP application is implemented using a single application + * function that is called by uIP whenever a TCP/IP event occurs. The + * name of this function must be registered with uIP at compile time + * using the UIP_APPCALL definition. + * + * uIP applications can store the application state within the + * uip_conn structure by specifying the type of the application + * structure by typedef:ing the type uip_tcp_appstate_t and uip_udp_appstate_t. + * + * The file containing the definitions must be included in the + * uipopt.h file. + * + * The following example illustrates how this can look. + \code + + void httpd_appcall(void); + #define UIP_APPCALL httpd_appcall + + struct httpd_state { + u8_t state; + u16_t count; + char *dataptr; + char *script; + }; + typedef struct httpd_state uip_tcp_appstate_t + \endcode +*/ +#define UIP_UDP_APPCALL uIPManagement_UDPCallback +void UIP_UDP_APPCALL(void); + +/** + * \var #define UIP_APPCALL + * + * The name of the application function that uIP should call in + * response to TCP/IP events. + * + */ +#define UIP_APPCALL uIPManagement_TCPCallback +void UIP_APPCALL(void); + +/** + * \var typedef uip_tcp_appstate_t + * + * The type of the application state that is to be stored in the + * uip_conn structure. This usually is typedef:ed to a struct holding + * application state information. + */ +typedef union +{ + struct + { + uint8_t CurrentState; + uint8_t NextState; + + char FileName[MAX_URI_LENGTH]; + FIL FileHandle; + bool FileOpen; + uint32_t ACKedFilePos; + uint16_t SentChunkSize; + } HTTPServer; + + struct + { + uint8_t CurrentState; + uint8_t NextState; + + uint8_t IssuedCommand; + } TELNETServer; +} uip_tcp_appstate_t; + +/** + * \var typedef uip_udp_appstate_t + * + * The type of the application state that is to be stored in the + * uip_conn structure. This usually is typedef:ed to a struct holding + * application state information. + */ +typedef union +{ + struct + { + uint8_t CurrentState; + struct timer Timeout; + + struct + { + uint8_t AllocatedIP[4]; + uint8_t Netmask[4]; + uint8_t GatewayIP[4]; + uint8_t ServerIP[4]; + } DHCPOffer_Data; + } DHCPClient; +} uip_udp_appstate_t; +/** @} */ + +#endif /* __UIPOPT_H__ */ +/** @} */ +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/USBDeviceMode.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/USBDeviceMode.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c883f1441d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/USBDeviceMode.c @@ -0,0 +1,162 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Mode management functions and variables. This file contains the LUFA code required to + * manage the USB Mass Storage device mode. + */ + +#include "USBDeviceMode.h" + +/** Message buffer for RNDIS messages processed by the RNDIS device class driver. */ +static uint8_t RNDIS_Message_Buffer[192]; + +/** LUFA RNDIS Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all RNDIS Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Device = + { + .Config = + { + .ControlInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .AdapterVendorDescription = "LUFA RNDIS Adapter", + .AdapterMACAddress = {{0x02, 0x00, 0x02, 0x00, 0x02, 0x00}}, + .MessageBuffer = RNDIS_Message_Buffer, + .MessageBufferLength = sizeof(RNDIS_Message_Buffer), + }, + }; + +/** LUFA Mass Storage Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all Mass Storage Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t Disk_MS_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_MassStorage, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = MASS_STORAGE_IN_EPADDR, + .Size = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = MASS_STORAGE_OUT_EPADDR, + .Size = MASS_STORAGE_IO_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .TotalLUNs = 1, + }, + }; + + +/** USB device mode management task. This function manages the Mass Storage Device class driver when the device is + * initialized in USB device mode. + */ +void USBDeviceMode_USBTask(void) +{ + if (USB_CurrentMode != USB_MODE_Device) + return; + + uIPManagement_ManageNetwork(); + + RNDIS_Device_USBTask(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Device); + MS_Device_USBTask(&Disk_MS_Interface); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + uIPManagement_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + ConfigSuccess &= RNDIS_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Device); + ConfigSuccess &= MS_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&Disk_MS_Interface); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + RNDIS_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Device); + MS_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&Disk_MS_Interface); +} + +/** Mass Storage class driver callback function the reception of SCSI commands from the host, which must be processed. + * + * \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface configuration structure being referenced + */ +bool CALLBACK_MS_Device_SCSICommandReceived(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ + bool CommandSuccess; + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + CommandSuccess = SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(MSInterfaceInfo); + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + + return CommandSuccess; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/USBDeviceMode.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/USBDeviceMode.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f714903332 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/USBDeviceMode.h @@ -0,0 +1,62 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for USBDeviceMode.c. + */ + +#ifndef _USBDEVICEMODE_H_ +#define _USBDEVICEMODE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "Webserver.h" + #include "Descriptors.h" + #include "Lib/uIPManagement.h" + #include "Lib/SCSI.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* External Variables: */ + extern USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Device_t Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Device; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void USBDeviceMode_USBTask(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + + bool CALLBACK_MS_Device_SCSICommandReceived(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/USBHostMode.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/USBHostMode.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..04190bfe20 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/USBHostMode.c @@ -0,0 +1,172 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Host Mode management functions and variables. This file contains the LUFA code required to + * manage the USB RNDIS host mode. + */ + +#include "USBHostMode.h" + +/** LUFA RNDIS Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all RNDIS Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Host = + { + .Config = + { + .DataINPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 1), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_OUT | 2), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .NotificationPipe = + { + .Address = (PIPE_DIR_IN | 3), + .Banks = 1, + }, + .HostMaxPacketSize = UIP_CONF_BUFFER_SIZE, + }, + }; + + +/** USB host mode management task. This function manages the RNDIS Host class driver and uIP stack when the device is + * initialized in USB host mode. + */ +void USBHostMode_USBTask(void) +{ + if (USB_CurrentMode != USB_MODE_Host) + return; + + uIPManagement_ManageNetwork(); + + RNDIS_Host_USBTask(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Host); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceAttached event. This indicates that a device has been attached to the host, and + * starts the library USB task to begin the enumeration and USB management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceUnattached event. This indicates that a device has been removed from the host, and + * stops the library USB task management process. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationComplete event. This indicates that a device has been successfully + * enumerated by the host and is now ready to be used by the application. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); + + uint16_t ConfigDescriptorSize; + uint8_t ConfigDescriptorData[512]; + + if (USB_Host_GetDeviceConfigDescriptor(1, &ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData, + sizeof(ConfigDescriptorData)) != HOST_GETCONFIG_Successful) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (RNDIS_Host_ConfigurePipes(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Host, + ConfigDescriptorSize, ConfigDescriptorData) != RNDIS_ENUMERROR_NoError) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(1) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + return; + } + + if (RNDIS_Host_InitializeDevice(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Host) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + uint32_t PacketFilter = (REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_DIRECTED | REMOTE_NDIS_PACKET_BROADCAST); + if (RNDIS_Host_SetRNDISProperty(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Host, OID_GEN_CURRENT_PACKET_FILTER, + &PacketFilter, sizeof(PacketFilter)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + if (RNDIS_Host_QueryRNDISProperty(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Host, OID_802_3_CURRENT_ADDRESS, + &MACAddress, sizeof(MACAddress)) != HOST_SENDCONTROL_Successful) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + USB_Host_SetDeviceConfiguration(0); + return; + } + + /* Initialize uIP stack */ + uIPManagement_Init(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_HostError event. This indicates that a hardware error occurred while in host mode. */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode) +{ + USB_Disable(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); + for(;;); +} + +/** Event handler for the USB_DeviceEnumerationFailed event. This indicates that a problem occurred while + * enumerating an attached USB device. + */ +void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, const uint8_t SubErrorCode) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/USBHostMode.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/USBHostMode.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b2c8d66ec7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/USBHostMode.h @@ -0,0 +1,60 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for USBHostMode.c. + */ + +#ifndef _USBHOSTMODE_H_ +#define _USBHOSTMODE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "Webserver.h" + #include "Lib/uIPManagement.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* External Variables: */ + extern USB_ClassInfo_RNDIS_Host_t Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Host; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void USBHostMode_USBTask(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Host_HostError(const uint8_t ErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceAttached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceUnattached(void); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationFailed(const uint8_t ErrorCode, + const uint8_t SubErrorCode); + void EVENT_USB_Host_DeviceEnumerationComplete(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Webserver.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Webserver.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bd8fa24ce6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Webserver.c @@ -0,0 +1,77 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the Webserver project. This file contains the main tasks of + * the project and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "Webserver.h" + +/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then + * enters a loop to run the application tasks in sequence. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + if (USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Host) + USBHostMode_USBTask(); + else + USBDeviceMode_USBTask(); + + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + Dataflash_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + USB_Init(USB_MODE_UID); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Webserver.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Webserver.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0438fe0b90 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Webserver.h @@ -0,0 +1,76 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for Webserver.c. + */ + +#ifndef _WEBSERVER_H_ +#define _WEBSERVER_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Peripheral/SPI.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + #include "USBDeviceMode.h" + #include "USBHostMode.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY LEDS_LED2 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3) + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_BUSY (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4) + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Webserver.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Webserver.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..10aa716528 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Webserver.txt @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage uIP Powered Webserver Project + * + * \section Sec_Compat Project Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this project. + * + * \li Series 7 USB AVRs (AT90USBxxx7) + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this project. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>Dual Mode Host/Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC) \n + * Mass Storage Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>Remote NDIS (Microsoft Proprietary CDC Class Networking Standard) \n + * Bulk-Only Transport</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>Microsoft RNDIS Specification \n + * USBIF Mass Storage Standard \n + * USB Bulk-Only Transport Standard \n + * SCSI Primary Commands Specification \n + * SCSI Block Commands Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * Simple HTTP webserver project. This project combines the LUFA library with the uIP TCP/IP full network stack and FatFS + * library to create a RNDIS host capable of serving out HTTP web pages to multiple hosts simultaneously. This project + * demonstrates how the libraries can be combined into a robust network enabled application, with the addition of a RNDIS + * network device. + * + * To use this project, plug the USB AVR into a computer, so that it enumerates as a standard Mass Storage and RNDIS composite + * device. Load HTML files onto the disk, so that they can be served out to clients -- the default file to serve should be called + * <i>index.htm</i>. Filenames must be in 8.3 format for them to be retrieved correctly by the webserver, and the total + * requested file path must be equal to or less than the maximum URI length (\see \ref Sec_Options). Supply the included INF + * file when requested on Windows machines to enable the RNDIS interface, and allow the files to be viewed on a standard web-browser + * using the IP address 10.0.0.2. + * + * When attached to a RNDIS class device, such as a USB (desktop) modem, the system will enumerate the device, set the + * appropriate parameters needed for connectivity and begin listening for new HTTP connections on port 80 and TELNET + * connections on port 23. The device IP, netmask and default gateway IP must be set to values appropriate for the RNDIS + * device being used for this project to work if the DHCP client is disabled (see \ref Sec_Options) - otherwise, the device + * will query the network's DHCP server for these parameters automatically. + * + * When properly configured, the webserver can be accessed from any HTTP web browser by typing in the device's statically or + * dynamically allocated IP address. The TELNET client can be accessed via any network socket app by connecting to the device + * on port 23 on the device's statically or dynamically allocated IP address. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this project, which can control the project behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ENABLE_TELNET_SERVER</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, this enables the TELNET server in addition to the HTTP webserver, which listens for incoming connections + * and processes user commands.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ENABLE_DHCP_CLIENT</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, this enables the DHCP client for dynamic IP allocation of the network settings from a DHCP server.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>ENABLE_DHCP_SERVER</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>When defined, this enables the DHCP server for dynamic IP allocation of the network settings to a DHCP client.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>DEVICE_IP_ADDRESS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>IP address that the webserver should use when connected to a RNDIS device (when ENABLE_DHCP_CLIENT is not defined).</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>DEVICE_NETMASK</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Netmask that the webserver should use when connected to a RNDIS device (when ENABLE_DHCP_CLIENT is not defined).</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>DEVICE_GATEWAY</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Default routing gateway that the webserver should use when connected to a RNDIS device (when ENABLE_DHCP_CLIENT + * is not defined).</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>MAX_URI_LENGTH</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Maximum length of a URI for the Webserver. This is the maximum file path, including subdirectories and separators.</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>MAC address of the server used when sending Ethernet packets onto the bus.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ca1733e85f --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,96 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0"> + <project caption="RNDIS Webserver" id="lufa.projects.webserver.avr8"> + <require idref="lufa.projects.webserver"/> + <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> + <generator value="as5_8"/> + + <device-support value="at90usb1287"/> + <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="usbkey"/> + + <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="8000000UL"/> + <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="8000000UL"/> + </project> + + <module type="application" id="lufa.projects.webserver" caption="RNDIS Webserver"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + RNDIS Webserver project, using the open source uIP network stack. + </info> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/> + + <info type="keyword" value="Technology"> + <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/> + <keyword value="USB Dual Role"/> + <keyword value="RNDIS Class"/> + <keyword value="Mass Storage Class"/> + </info> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/> + <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="Webserver.txt"/> + <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="LUFA Webserver RNDIS.inf"/> + + <build type="c-source" value="Webserver.c"/> + <build type="c-source" value="USBDeviceMode.c"/> + <build type="c-source" value="USBHostMode.c"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Descriptors.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Webserver.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="USBDeviceMode.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="USBHostMode.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Descriptors.h"/> + + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/DataflashManager.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/DataflashManager.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/DHCPClientApp.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/DHCPClientApp.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/DHCPCommon.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/DHCPCommon.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/DHCPServerApp.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/DHCPServerApp.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/HTTPServerApp.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/HTTPServerApp.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/SCSI.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/SCSI.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/TELNETServerApp.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/TELNETServerApp.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/uIPManagement.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/uIPManagement.h"/> + + <build type="include-path" value="Lib/FATFs/"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/FATFs/ff.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/FATFs/ff.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/FATFs/diskio.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/FATFs/diskio.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/FATFs/ffconf.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/FATFs/integer.h"/> + + <build type="include-path" value="Lib/uip/"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/uip/clock.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/uip/clock.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/uip/timer.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/uip/timer.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/uip/uip.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/uip/uip.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/uip/uip_arp.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/uip/uip_arp.h"/> + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/uip/uip-split.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/uip/uip-split.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/uip/uipopt.h"/> + + <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/> + <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/> + + <require idref="lufa.common"/> + <require idref="lufa.platform"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.dataflash"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.peripheral.spi"/> + </module> +</asf> diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0f01c93b3d --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2396 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - uIP Powered Webserver Project" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = */uip/* \ + */FATFs/* + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/makefile b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..852d011bcf --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,46 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = USBKEY +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = Webserver +SRC = $(TARGET).c Descriptors.c USBDeviceMode.c USBHostMode.c Lib/SCSI.c Lib/DataflashManager.c \ + Lib/uIPManagement.c Lib/DHCPCommon.c Lib/DHCPClientApp.c Lib/DHCPServerApp.c Lib/HTTPServerApp.c \ + Lib/TELNETServerApp.c Lib/uip/uip.c Lib/uip/uip_arp.c Lib/uip/timer.c Lib/uip/clock.c \ + Lib/uip/uip-split.c Lib/FATFs/diskio.c Lib/FATFs/ff.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ -ILib/uip/ -ILib/FATFs/ +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/Config/AppConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/Config/AppConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ce9caaf616 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/Config/AppConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,64 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief Application Configuration Header File + * + * This is a header file which is be used to configure some of + * the application's compile time options, as an alternative to + * specifying the compile time constants supplied through a + * makefile or build system. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the + * \ref Sec_Options section of the application documentation. + */ + +#ifndef _APP_CONFIG_H_ +#define _APP_CONFIG_H_ + + #define AUX_LINE_PORT PORTB + #define AUX_LINE_PIN PINB + #define AUX_LINE_DDR DDRB + #define AUX_LINE_MASK (1 << 4) + +// #define ENABLE_ISP_PROTOCOL + #define ENABLE_XPROG_PROTOCOL + + #define VTARGET_ADC_CHANNEL 2 + #define VTARGET_REF_VOLTS 3.3 + #define VTARGET_SCALE_FACTOR 2 +// #define VTARGET_USE_INTERNAL_REF +// #define NO_VTARGET_DETECT +// #define XCK_RESCUE_CLOCK_ENABLE +// #define INVERTED_ISP_MISO + +// #define FIRMWARE_VERSION_MINOR 0x11 + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/Config/LUFAConfig.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/Config/LUFAConfig.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2767f33e32 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/Config/LUFAConfig.h @@ -0,0 +1,93 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * \brief LUFA Library Configuration Header File + * + * This header file is used to configure LUFA's compile time options, + * as an alternative to the compile time constants supplied through + * a makefile. + * + * For information on what each token does, refer to the LUFA + * manual section "Summary of Compile Tokens". + */ + +#ifndef _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ +#define _LUFA_CONFIG_H_ + + #if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + + /* Non-USB Related Configuration Tokens: */ +// #define DISABLE_TERMINAL_CODES + + /* USB Class Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HID_HOST_BOOT_PROTOCOL_ONLY +// #define HID_STATETABLE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_USAGE_STACK_DEPTH {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_COLLECTIONS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORTITEMS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HID_MAX_REPORT_IDS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_CLASS_DRIVER_AUTOFLUSH + + /* General USB Driver Related Tokens: */ + #define ORDERED_EP_CONFIG + #define USE_STATIC_OPTIONS (USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL) + #define USB_DEVICE_ONLY +// #define USB_HOST_ONLY +// #define USB_STREAM_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_LIMITED_CONTROLLER_CONNECT + #define NO_SOF_EVENTS + + /* USB Device Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define USE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS + #define USE_FLASH_DESCRIPTORS +// #define USE_EEPROM_DESCRIPTORS +// #define NO_INTERNAL_SERIAL + #define FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE 16 + #define DEVICE_STATE_AS_GPIOR 0 + #define FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS 1 +// #define CONTROL_ONLY_DEVICE +// #define INTERRUPT_CONTROL_ENDPOINT + #define NO_DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP + #define NO_DEVICE_SELF_POWER + + /* USB Host Mode Driver Related Tokens: */ +// #define HOST_STATE_AS_GPIOR {Insert Value Here} +// #define USB_HOST_TIMEOUT_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define HOST_DEVICE_SETTLE_DELAY_MS {Insert Value Here} +// #define NO_AUTO_VBUS_MANAGEMENT +// #define INVERTED_VBUS_ENABLE_LINE + + #else + + #error Unsupported architecture for this LUFA configuration file. + + #endif +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/LUFA XPLAIN Bridge.inf b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/LUFA XPLAIN Bridge.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..45840e8bf0 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/LUFA XPLAIN Bridge.inf @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +;************************************************************ +; Windows USB CDC ACM Setup File +; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation +;************************************************************ + +[DefaultInstall] +CopyINF="LUFA XPLAIN Bridge.inf" + +[Version] +Signature="$Windows NT$" +Class=Ports +ClassGuid={4D36E978-E325-11CE-BFC1-08002BE10318} +Provider=%MFGNAME% +DriverVer=7/1/2012,10.0.0.0 + +[Manufacturer] +%MFGNAME%=DeviceList, NTx86, NTamd64, NTia64 + +[SourceDisksNames] + +[SourceDisksFiles] + +[DestinationDirs] +DefaultDestDir=12 + +[DriverInstall] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +CopyFiles=FakeModemCopyFileSection +AddReg=DriverInstall.AddReg + +[DriverInstall.Services] +Include=mdmcpq.inf +AddService=usbser, 0x00000002, LowerFilter_Service_Inst + +[DriverInstall.AddReg] +HKR,,EnumPropPages32,,"msports.dll,SerialPortPropPageProvider" + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; Vendor and Product ID Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; When developing your USB device, the VID and PID used in the PC side +; application program and the firmware on the microcontroller must match. +; Modify the below line to use your VID and PID. Use the format as shown below. +; Note: One INF file can be used for multiple devices with different VID and PIDs. +; For each supported device, append ",USB\VID_xxxx&PID_yyyy" to the end of the line. +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[DeviceList] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204B + +[DeviceList.NTx86] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204B + +[DeviceList.NTamd64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204B + +[DeviceList.NTia64] +%DESCRIPTION%=DriverInstall, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204B + +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +; String Definitions +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +;Modify these strings to customize your device +;------------------------------------------------------------------------------ +[Strings] +MFGNAME="http://www.lufa-lib.org" +DESCRIPTION="LUFA XPLAIN Bridge"
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/Lib/SoftUART.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/Lib/SoftUART.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5c0e3c8cd9 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/Lib/SoftUART.c @@ -0,0 +1,156 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2010 David Prentice (david.prentice [at] farming [dot] uk) + Copyright 2010 Peter Danneger + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Software UART for both data transmission and reception. This + * code continuously monitors the ring buffers set up by the main + * project source file and reads/writes data as it becomes available. + */ + +#include "SoftUART.h" + +/** Total number of bits remaining to be sent in the current frame */ +static uint8_t TX_BitsRemaining; + +/** Temporary data variable to hold the byte being transmitted as it is shifted out */ +static uint8_t TX_Data; + +/** Total number of bits remaining to be received in the current frame */ +static uint8_t RX_BitsRemaining; + +/** Temporary data variable to hold the byte being received as it is shifted in */ +static uint8_t RX_Data; + + +/** Initializes the software UART, ready for data transmission and reception into the global ring buffers. */ +void SoftUART_Init(void) +{ + /* Set TX pin to output high, enable RX pull-up */ + STXPORT |= (1 << STX); + STXDDR |= (1 << STX); + SRXPORT |= (1 << SRX); + + /* Enable INT0 for the detection of incoming start bits that signal the start of a byte */ + EICRA = (1 << ISC01); + EIMSK = (1 << INT0); + + /* Set the transmission and reception timer compare values for the default baud rate */ + SoftUART_SetBaud(9600); + + /* Setup reception timer compare ISR */ + TIMSK1 = (1 << OCIE1A); + + /* Setup transmission timer compare ISR and start the timer */ + TIMSK3 = (1 << OCIE3A); + TCCR3B = ((1 << CS30) | (1 << WGM32)); +} + +/** ISR to detect the start of a bit being sent to the software UART. */ +ISR(INT0_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + /* Reset the number of reception bits remaining counter */ + RX_BitsRemaining = 8; + + /* Reset the bit reception timer to -(1/2) of the total bit time, so that the first data bit is + * sampled mid way through the total bit time, making reception more robust. + */ + TCNT1 = -(OCR1A >> 1); + + /* Check to see that the pin is still low (prevents glitches from starting a frame reception) */ + if (!(SRXPIN & (1 << SRX))) + { + /* Disable start bit detection ISR while the next byte is received */ + EIMSK = 0; + + /* Start the reception timer */ + TCCR1B = ((1 << CS10) | (1 << WGM12)); + } +} + +/** ISR to manage the reception of bits to the software UART. */ +ISR(TIMER1_COMPA_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + /* Cache the current RX pin value for later checking */ + uint8_t SRX_Cached = (SRXPIN & (1 << SRX)); + + /* Check if reception has finished */ + if (RX_BitsRemaining) + { + /* Shift the current received bit mask to the next bit position */ + RX_Data >>= 1; + RX_BitsRemaining--; + + /* Store next bit into the received data variable */ + if (SRX_Cached) + RX_Data |= (1 << 7); + } + else + { + /* Disable the reception timer as all data has now been received, re-enable start bit detection ISR */ + TCCR1B = 0; + EIFR = (1 << INTF0); + EIMSK = (1 << INT0); + + /* Reception complete, store the received byte if stop bit valid */ + if (SRX_Cached) + RingBuffer_Insert(&UARTtoUSB_Buffer, RX_Data); + } +} + +/** ISR to manage the transmission of bits via the software UART. */ +ISR(TIMER3_COMPA_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ + /* Check if transmission has finished */ + if (TX_BitsRemaining) + { + /* Set the TX line to the value of the next bit in the byte to send */ + if (TX_Data & (1 << 0)) + STXPORT &= ~(1 << STX); + else + STXPORT |= (1 << STX); + + /* Shift the transmission byte to move the next bit into position and decrement the bits remaining counter */ + TX_Data >>= 1; + TX_BitsRemaining--; + } + else if (!(RX_BitsRemaining) && !(RingBuffer_IsEmpty(&USBtoUART_Buffer))) + { + /* Start bit - TX line low */ + STXPORT &= ~(1 << STX); + + /* Transmission complete, get the next byte to send (if available) */ + TX_Data = ~RingBuffer_Remove(&USBtoUART_Buffer); + TX_BitsRemaining = 9; + } +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/Lib/SoftUART.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/Lib/SoftUART.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b273967814 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/Lib/SoftUART.h @@ -0,0 +1,71 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2010 David Prentice (david.prentice [at] farming [dot] uk) + Copyright 2010 Peter Danneger + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for SoftUART.c. + */ + +#ifndef _SOFT_UART_ +#define _SOFT_UART_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <stdbool.h> + + #include "../XPLAINBridge.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + #define SRX PD0 + #define SRXPIN PIND + #define SRXPORT PORTD + + #define STX PD1 + #define STXPORT PORTD + #define STXDDR DDRD + + /* Inline Functions: */ + static inline void SoftUART_SetBaud(const uint32_t Baud) + { + uint16_t BitTime = ((F_CPU / Baud) - 1); + + OCR1A = BitTime; + OCR3A = BitTime; + } + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SoftUART_Init(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/USARTDescriptors.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/USARTDescriptors.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..54f0d96fe6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/USARTDescriptors.c @@ -0,0 +1,242 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special + * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine + * the device's capabilities and functions. + */ + +#include "USARTDescriptors.h" + + +/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall + * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the + * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration + * process begins. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM USART_DeviceDescriptor = +{ + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), .Type = DTYPE_Device}, + + .USBSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoSpecificProtocol, + + .Endpoint0Size = FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE, + + .VendorID = 0x03EB, + .ProductID = 0x204B, + .ReleaseNumber = VERSION_BCD(0,0,1), + + .ManufacturerStrIndex = USART_STRING_ID_Manufacturer, + .ProductStrIndex = USART_STRING_ID_Product, + .SerialNumStrIndex = USE_INTERNAL_SERIAL, + + .NumberOfConfigurations = FIXED_NUM_CONFIGURATIONS +}; + +/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage + * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces + * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting + * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device. + */ +const USART_USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM USART_ConfigurationDescriptor = +{ + .Config = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), .Type = DTYPE_Configuration}, + + .TotalConfigurationSize = sizeof(USART_USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t), + .TotalInterfaces = 2, + + .ConfigurationNumber = 1, + .ConfigurationStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR, + + .ConfigAttributes = USB_CONFIG_ATTR_RESERVED, + + .MaxPowerConsumption = USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100) + }, + + .CDC_CCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 1, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_ACMSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_ATCommandProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Header = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Header, + + .CDCSpecification = VERSION_BCD(1,1,0), + }, + + .CDC_Functional_ACM = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_ACM, + + .Capabilities = 0x06, + }, + + .CDC_Functional_Union = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t), .Type = DTYPE_CSInterface}, + .Subtype = CDC_DSUBTYPE_CSInterface_Union, + + .MasterInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .SlaveInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + }, + + .CDC_NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0xFF + }, + + .CDC_DCI_Interface = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), .Type = DTYPE_Interface}, + + .InterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI, + .AlternateSetting = 0, + + .TotalEndpoints = 2, + + .Class = CDC_CSCP_CDCDataClass, + .SubClass = CDC_CSCP_NoDataSubclass, + .Protocol = CDC_CSCP_NoDataProtocol, + + .InterfaceStrIndex = NO_DESCRIPTOR + }, + + .CDC_DataOutEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + }, + + .CDC_DataInEndpoint = + { + .Header = {.Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), .Type = DTYPE_Endpoint}, + + .EndpointAddress = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Attributes = (EP_TYPE_BULK | ENDPOINT_ATTR_NO_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA), + .EndpointSize = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .PollingIntervalMS = 0x05 + } +}; + +/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests + * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate + * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM USART_LanguageString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR_ARRAY(LANGUAGE_ID_ENG); + +/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable + * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM USART_ManufacturerString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"Dean Camera"); + +/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form, + * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device + * Descriptor. + */ +const USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM USART_ProductString = USB_STRING_DESCRIPTOR(L"LUFA XPLAIN Bridge"); + +/** Descriptor retrieval function for the USART Bridge descriptors. This function is in turn called by the GetDescriptor + * callback function in the main source file, to retrieve the device's descriptors when in USART bridge mode. + */ +uint16_t USART_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8); + const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF); + + const void* Address = NULL; + uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR; + + switch (DescriptorType) + { + case DTYPE_Device: + Address = &USART_DeviceDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t); + break; + case DTYPE_Configuration: + Address = &USART_ConfigurationDescriptor; + Size = sizeof(USART_USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t); + break; + case DTYPE_String: + switch (DescriptorNumber) + { + case USART_STRING_ID_Language: + Address = &USART_LanguageString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&USART_LanguageString.Header.Size); + break; + case USART_STRING_ID_Manufacturer: + Address = &USART_ManufacturerString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&USART_ManufacturerString.Header.Size); + break; + case USART_STRING_ID_Product: + Address = &USART_ProductString; + Size = pgm_read_byte(&USART_ProductString.Header.Size); + break; + } + + break; + } + + *DescriptorAddress = Address; + return Size; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/USARTDescriptors.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/USARTDescriptors.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4f165a1e16 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/USARTDescriptors.h @@ -0,0 +1,111 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for USARTDescriptors.c. + */ + +#ifndef _USART_DESCRIPTORS_H_ +#define _USART_DESCRIPTORS_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/pgmspace.h> + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + /* Macros: */ + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 2) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC device-to-host data IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_TX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_IN | 3) + + /** Endpoint address of the CDC host-to-device data OUT endpoint. */ + #define CDC_RX_EPADDR (ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT | 4) + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC device-to-host notification IN endpoint. */ + #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE 8 + + /** Size in bytes of the CDC data IN and OUT endpoints. */ + #define CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE 16 + + /* Type Defines: */ + /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the + * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which + * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host. + */ + typedef struct + { + USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config; + + // CDC Control Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_CCI_Interface; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalHeader_t CDC_Functional_Header; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalACM_t CDC_Functional_ACM; + USB_CDC_Descriptor_FunctionalUnion_t CDC_Functional_Union; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_NotificationEndpoint; + + // CDC Data Interface + USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CDC_DCI_Interface; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataOutEndpoint; + USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t CDC_DataInEndpoint; + } USART_USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t; + + /** Enum for the device interface descriptor IDs within the device. Each interface descriptor + * should have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the + * interface from other descriptors. + */ + enum USART_InterfaceDescriptors_t + { + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI = 0, /**< CDC CCI interface descriptor ID */ + INTERFACE_ID_CDC_DCI = 1, /**< CDC DCI interface descriptor ID */ + }; + + /** Enum for the device string descriptor IDs within the device. Each string descriptor should + * have a unique ID index associated with it, which can be used to refer to the string from + * other descriptors. + */ + enum USART_StringDescriptors_t + { + USART_STRING_ID_Language = 0, /**< Supported Languages string descriptor ID (must be zero) */ + USART_STRING_ID_Manufacturer = 1, /**< Manufacturer string ID */ + USART_STRING_ID_Product = 2, /**< Product string ID */ + }; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + uint16_t USART_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/XPLAINBridge.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/XPLAINBridge.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d901af819c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/XPLAINBridge.c @@ -0,0 +1,292 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Main source file for the XPLAINBridge project. This file contains the main tasks of + * the project and is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration. + */ + +#include "XPLAINBridge.h" + +/** Current firmware mode, making the device behave as either a programmer or a USART bridge */ +bool CurrentFirmwareMode = MODE_USART_BRIDGE; + +/** LUFA CDC Class driver interface configuration and state information. This structure is + * passed to all CDC Class driver functions, so that multiple instances of the same class + * within a device can be differentiated from one another. + */ +USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface = + { + .Config = + { + .ControlInterfaceNumber = INTERFACE_ID_CDC_CCI, + .DataINEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_TX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .DataOUTEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_RX_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + .NotificationEndpoint = + { + .Address = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPADDR, + .Size = CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE, + .Banks = 1, + }, + }, + }; + +/** Circular buffer to hold data from the host before it is sent to the device via the serial port. */ +RingBuffer_t USBtoUART_Buffer; + +/** Underlying data buffer for \ref USBtoUART_Buffer, where the stored bytes are located. */ +static uint8_t USBtoUART_Buffer_Data[128]; + +/** Circular buffer to hold data from the serial port before it is sent to the host. */ +RingBuffer_t UARTtoUSB_Buffer; + +/** Underlying data buffer for \ref UARTtoUSB_Buffer, where the stored bytes are located. */ +static uint8_t UARTtoUSB_Buffer_Data[128]; + + +/** Main program entry point. This routine contains the overall program flow, including initial + * setup of all components and the main program loop. + */ +int main(void) +{ + SetupHardware(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); + GlobalInterruptEnable(); + + for (;;) + { + if (CurrentFirmwareMode == MODE_USART_BRIDGE) + UARTBridge_Task(); + else + AVRISP_Task(); + + USB_USBTask(); + } +} + +void AVRISP_Task(void) +{ + /* Must be in the configured state for the AVRISP code to process data */ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + V2Params_UpdateParamValues(); + + Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_OUT_EPADDR); + + /* Check to see if a V2 Protocol command has been received */ + if (Endpoint_IsOUTReceived()) + { + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_BUSY); + + /* Pass off processing of the V2 Protocol command to the V2 Protocol handler */ + V2Protocol_ProcessCommand(); + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); + } +} + +void UARTBridge_Task(void) +{ + /* Must be in the configured state for the USART Bridge code to process data */ + if (USB_DeviceState != DEVICE_STATE_Configured) + return; + + /* Only try to read in bytes from the CDC interface if the transmit buffer is not full */ + if (!(RingBuffer_IsFull(&USBtoUART_Buffer))) + { + int16_t ReceivedByte = CDC_Device_ReceiveByte(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + + /* Read bytes from the USB OUT endpoint into the UART transmit buffer */ + if (!(ReceivedByte < 0)) + RingBuffer_Insert(&USBtoUART_Buffer, ReceivedByte); + } + + /* Check if the UART receive buffer flush timer has expired or buffer is nearly full */ + uint16_t BufferCount = RingBuffer_GetCount(&UARTtoUSB_Buffer); + if ((TIFR0 & (1 << TOV0)) || (BufferCount > 200)) + { + /* Clear flush timer expiry flag */ + TIFR0 |= (1 << TOV0); + + /* Read bytes from the USART receive buffer into the USB IN endpoint */ + while (BufferCount--) + { + /* Try to send the next byte of data to the host, abort if there is an error without dequeuing */ + if (CDC_Device_SendByte(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface, + RingBuffer_Peek(&UARTtoUSB_Buffer)) != ENDPOINT_READYWAIT_NoError) + { + break; + } + + /* Dequeue the already sent byte from the buffer now we have confirmed that no transmission error occurred */ + RingBuffer_Remove(&UARTtoUSB_Buffer); + } + } + + CDC_Device_USBTask(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); +} + +/** Configures the board hardware and chip peripherals for the demo's functionality. */ +void SetupHardware(void) +{ +#if (ARCH == ARCH_AVR8) + /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */ + MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF); + wdt_disable(); + + /* Disable clock division */ + clock_prescale_set(clock_div_1); +#endif + + /* Disable JTAG debugging */ + MCUCR |= (1 << JTD); + MCUCR |= (1 << JTD); + + /* Enable pull-up on the JTAG TDI pin so we can use it to select the mode */ + PORTF |= (1 << 7); + Delay_MS(10); + + /* Select the firmware mode based on the JTD pin's value */ + CurrentFirmwareMode = (PINF & (1 << 7)) ? MODE_USART_BRIDGE : MODE_PDI_PROGRAMMER; + + /* Re-enable JTAG debugging */ + MCUCR &= ~(1 << JTD); + MCUCR &= ~(1 << JTD); + + /* Hardware Initialization */ + SoftUART_Init(); + LEDs_Init(); + #if defined(RESET_TOGGLES_LIBUSB_COMPAT) + UpdateCurrentCompatibilityMode(); + #endif + + /* USB Stack Initialization */ + USB_Init(); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Configuration Changed event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void) +{ + bool ConfigSuccess = true; + + /* Configure the device endpoints according to the selected mode */ + if (CurrentFirmwareMode == MODE_USART_BRIDGE) + { + ConfigSuccess &= CDC_Device_ConfigureEndpoints(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); + + /* Configure the UART flush timer - run at Fcpu/1024 for maximum interval before overflow */ + TCCR0B = ((1 << CS02) | (1 << CS00)); + + /* Initialize ring buffers used to hold serial data between USB and software UART interfaces */ + RingBuffer_InitBuffer(&USBtoUART_Buffer, USBtoUART_Buffer_Data, sizeof(USBtoUART_Buffer_Data)); + RingBuffer_InitBuffer(&UARTtoUSB_Buffer, UARTtoUSB_Buffer_Data, sizeof(UARTtoUSB_Buffer_Data)); + + /* Start the software USART */ + SoftUART_Init(); + } + else + { + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_OUT_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, AVRISP_DATA_EPSIZE, 1); + + if ((AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK) != (AVRISP_DATA_OUT_EPADDR & ENDPOINT_EPNUM_MASK)) + ConfigSuccess &= Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(AVRISP_DATA_IN_EPADDR, EP_TYPE_BULK, AVRISP_DATA_EPSIZE, 1); + + /* Configure the V2 protocol packet handler */ + V2Protocol_Init(); + } + + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(ConfigSuccess ? LEDMASK_USB_READY : LEDMASK_USB_ERROR); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Control Request reception event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void) +{ + if (CurrentFirmwareMode == MODE_USART_BRIDGE) + CDC_Device_ProcessControlRequest(&VirtualSerial_CDC_Interface); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Connection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING); +} + +/** Event handler for the library USB Disconnection event. */ +void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void) +{ + LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY); +} + +/** Event handler for the CDC Class driver Line Encoding Changed event. + * + * \param[in] CDCInterfaceInfo Pointer to the CDC class interface configuration structure being referenced + */ +void EVENT_CDC_Device_LineEncodingChanged(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo) +{ + /* Change the software UART's baud rate to match the new baud rate */ + SoftUART_SetBaud(CDCInterfaceInfo->State.LineEncoding.BaudRateBPS); +} + +/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see library "USB Descriptors" + * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given + * to the USB library. When the device receives a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function + * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the + * USB host. + * + * \param[in] wValue Descriptor type and index to retrieve + * \param[in] wIndex Sub-index to retrieve (such as a localized string language) + * \param[out] DescriptorAddress Address of the retrieved descriptor + * + * \return Length of the retrieved descriptor in bytes, or NO_DESCRIPTOR if the descriptor was not found + */ +uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) +{ + /* Return the correct descriptors based on the selected mode */ + if (CurrentFirmwareMode == MODE_USART_BRIDGE) + return USART_GetDescriptor(wValue, wIndex, DescriptorAddress); + else + return AVRISP_GetDescriptor(wValue, wIndex, DescriptorAddress); +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/XPLAINBridge.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/XPLAINBridge.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cc7d5b4997 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/XPLAINBridge.h @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* + LUFA Library + Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* + Copyright 2017 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + + Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this + software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted + without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in + all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this + permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting + documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in + advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the + software without specific, written prior permission. + + The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this + software, including all implied warranties of merchantability + and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any + special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages + whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether + in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, + arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of + this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + * Header file for XPLAINBridge.c. + */ + +#ifndef _XPLAIN_BRIDGE_H_ +#define _XPLAIN_BRIDGE_H_ + + /* Includes: */ + #include <avr/io.h> + #include <avr/wdt.h> + #include <avr/power.h> + #include <avr/interrupt.h> + #include <util/delay.h> + + #include "USARTDescriptors.h" + + #include "AVRISPDescriptors.h" + #include "Lib/V2Protocol.h" + #include "Lib/SoftUART.h" + #include "Config/AppConfig.h" + + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/Misc/RingBuffer.h> + #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + #include <LUFA/Platform/Platform.h> + + /* Macros: */ + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is not ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_NOTREADY LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is enumerating. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ENUMERATING LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is ready. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_READY LEDS_NO_LEDS + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that an error has occurred in the USB interface. */ + #define LEDMASK_USB_ERROR LEDS_LED1 + + /** LED mask for the library LED driver, to indicate that the USB interface is busy. */ + #define LEDMASK_BUSY LEDS_LED1 + + /** Firmware mode define for the USART Bridge mode. */ + #define MODE_USART_BRIDGE false + + /** Firmware mode define for the AVRISP Programmer mode. */ + #define MODE_PDI_PROGRAMMER true + + /* External Variables: */ + extern bool CurrentFirmwareMode; + extern RingBuffer_t UARTtoUSB_Buffer; + extern RingBuffer_t USBtoUART_Buffer; + + /* Function Prototypes: */ + void SetupHardware(void); + void AVRISP_Task(void); + void UARTBridge_Task(void); + + void EVENT_USB_Device_ConfigurationChanged(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_ControlRequest(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Connect(void); + void EVENT_USB_Device_Disconnect(void); + + void EVENT_CDC_Device_LineEncodingChanged(USB_ClassInfo_CDC_Device_t* const CDCInterfaceInfo); + + uint16_t CALLBACK_USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, + const uint16_t wIndex, + const void** const DescriptorAddress) + ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/XPLAINBridge.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/XPLAINBridge.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0cf59a67d7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/XPLAINBridge.txt @@ -0,0 +1,89 @@ +/** \file + * + * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special + * documentation pages. It is not a project source file. + */ + +/** \mainpage XPLAIN UART Bridge/PDI Programmer Project + * + * \section Sec_Compat Project Compatibility: + * + * The following list indicates what microcontrollers are compatible with this project. + * + * \li AT90USB1287 + * + * \section Sec_Info USB Information: + * + * The following table gives a rundown of the USB utilization of this project. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td> + * <td>1) Device</td> + * <td>2) Device</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td> + * <td>1) Communications Device Class (CDC)</td> + * <td>2) Vendor Specific Class</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td> + * <td>1) Abstract Control Model (ACM)</td> + * <td>2) N/A</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td> + * <td>1) USBIF CDC Class Standard</td> + * <td>2) Atmel AVRISP MKII Protocol Specification</td> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td><b>Supported USB Speeds:</b></td> + * <td>1) Full Speed Mode</td> + * <td>2) Full Speed Mode</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + * + * \section Sec_Description Project Description: + * + * This project serves a dual purpose. When loaded into the USB AVR on the XPLAIN board, it will act as either a USB to Serial + * converter for the XPLAIN's hardware USART (at a speed of 9600 baud), or an AVRStudio compatible PDI programmer for the XMEGA. + * This project replaces the firmware preloaded onto the XPLAIN's onboard AT90USB1287 microcontroller. + * + * When power to the board is applied, the TDI pin (pin 9) of the USB AVR's JTAG port is read. If the pin is left high, the device + * will enumerate as a regular COM port on the host, which can then be opened and data exchanged between the XMEGA and Host as if + * the XMEGA was connected directly to the host's serial port. If the pin is pulled low by shorting it to GND (pin 10), the device + * will enumerate as an AVRISP-MKII to the host, so that the XMEGA can be reprogrammed by AVRStudio or other compatible software + * such as avrdude by connecting to the board as if it was an Atmel AVRISP-MKII programmer. + * + * After running this project in serial bridge mode for the first time on a new computer, you will need to supply the .INF file + * located in this project project's directory as the device's driver when running under Windows. This will enable Windows to use + * its inbuilt CDC virtual serial drivers, negating the need for custom drivers for the device. Other Operating Systems should + * automatically use their own inbuilt CDC-ACM drivers. + * + * In serial bridge mode, the UART baud rate can be altered through the host terminal software to select a new baud rate - the default + * baud is 9600. Note that parity, data bits and stop bits are fixed at none, eight and one respectively can cannot be altered. Changes + * to the connection's parity, data bits or stop bits are ignored by the firmware. As the serial link between the controllers on the + * XPLAIN is software emulated by the USB AVR, not all baud rates will work correctly. + * + * This project relies on files from the LUFA AVRISP-MKII project for compilation. + * + * \section Sec_Options Project Options + * + * The following defines can be found in this project, which can control the project behaviour when defined, or changed in value. + * + * <table> + * <tr> + * <th><b>Define Name:</b></th> + * <th><b>Location:</b></th> + * <th><b>Description:</b></th> + * </tr> + * <tr> + * <td>FIRMWARE_VERSION_MINOR</td> + * <td>AppConfig.h</td> + * <td>Define to set the minor firmware revision nunber reported to the host on request. By default this will use a firmware version compatible + * with the latest Atmel IDE version, however if desired the reported minor value can be adjusted here.</td> + * </tr> + * </table> + */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/asf.xml b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/asf.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3530332ba1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/asf.xml @@ -0,0 +1,57 @@ +<asf xmlversion="1.0"> + <project caption="XPLAIN Bridge" id="lufa.projects.xplain_bridge.avr8"> + <require idref="lufa.projects.xplain_bridge"/> + <require idref="lufa.boards.dummy.avr8"/> + <generator value="as5_8"/> + + <device-support value="at90usb1287"/> + <config name="lufa.drivers.board.name" value="xplain"/> + + <build type="define" name="F_CPU" value="8000000UL"/> + <build type="define" name="F_USB" value="8000000UL"/> + </project> + + <module type="application" id="lufa.projects.xplain_bridge" caption="XPLAIN Bridge"> + <info type="description" value="summary"> + Bridge firmware for the original (green) XPLAIN board, for programming and USB virtual serial communications. + </info> + + <info type="gui-flag" value="move-to-root"/> + + <info type="keyword" value="Technology"> + <keyword value="Class Driver APIs"/> + <keyword value="USB Device"/> + <keyword value="CDC Class"/> + </info> + + <device-support-alias value="lufa_avr8"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_xmega"/> + <device-support-alias value="lufa_uc3"/> + + <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="doxyfile"/> + <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="XPLAINBridge.txt"/> + <build type="distribute" subtype="user-file" value="LUFA XPLAIN Bridge.inf"/> + + <build type="c-source" value="XPLAINBridge.c"/> + <build type="c-source" value="USARTDescriptors.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="XPLAINBridge.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="USARTDescriptors.h"/> + + <build type="c-source" value="Lib/SoftUART.c"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Lib/SoftUART.h"/> + + <require idref="lufa.projects.avrispmkii_clone.src"/> + + <build type="module-config" subtype="path" value="Config"/> + <build type="module-config" subtype="required-header-file" value="AppConfig.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Config/AppConfig.h"/> + <build type="header-file" value="Config/LUFAConfig.h"/> + + <require idref="lufa.common"/> + <require idref="lufa.platform"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.usb"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.misc.ringbuffer"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.board"/> + <require idref="lufa.drivers.board.leds"/> + </module> +</asf> diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/doxyfile b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/doxyfile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..15ae5a0d70 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/doxyfile @@ -0,0 +1,2395 @@ +# Doxyfile 1.8.9 + +# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system +# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project. +# +# All text after a double hash (##) is considered a comment and is placed in +# front of the TAG it is preceding. +# +# All text after a single hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored. +# The format is: +# TAG = value [value, ...] +# For lists, items can also be appended using: +# TAG += value [value, ...] +# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (\" \"). + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Project related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file +# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all text +# before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv +# built into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv +# for the list of possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded by +# double-quotes, unless you are using Doxywizard) that should identify the +# project for which the documentation is generated. This name is used in the +# title of most generated pages and in a few other places. +# The default value is: My Project. + +PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - XPLAIN Serial Bridge/PDI Programmer Project" + +# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. This +# could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or if some version +# control system is used. + +PROJECT_NUMBER = + +# Using the PROJECT_BRIEF tag one can provide an optional one line description +# for a project that appears at the top of each page and should give viewer a +# quick idea about the purpose of the project. Keep the description short. + +PROJECT_BRIEF = + +# With the PROJECT_LOGO tag one can specify a logo or an icon that is included +# in the documentation. The maximum height of the logo should not exceed 55 +# pixels and the maximum width should not exceed 200 pixels. Doxygen will copy +# the logo to the output directory. + +PROJECT_LOGO = + +# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) path +# into which the generated documentation will be written. If a relative path is +# entered, it will be relative to the location where doxygen was started. If +# left blank the current directory will be used. + +OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/ + +# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES then doxygen will create 4096 sub- +# directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output format and +# will distribute the generated files over these directories. Enabling this +# option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of source files, where +# putting all generated files in the same directory would otherwise causes +# performance problems for the file system. +# The default value is: NO. + +CREATE_SUBDIRS = NO + +# If the ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will allow non-ASCII +# characters to appear in the names of generated files. If set to NO, non-ASCII +# characters will be escaped, for example _xE3_x81_x84 will be used for Unicode +# U+3044. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLOW_UNICODE_NAMES = NO + +# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all +# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this +# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. +# Possible values are: Afrikaans, Arabic, Armenian, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, +# Chinese-Traditional, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (United States), +# Esperanto, Farsi (Persian), Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, +# Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), +# Korean, Korean-en (Korean with English messages), Latvian, Lithuanian, +# Macedonian, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, +# Serbian, Serbian-Cyrillic, Slovak, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish, +# Ukrainian and Vietnamese. +# The default value is: English. + +OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English + +# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES, doxygen will include brief member +# descriptions after the members that are listed in the file and class +# documentation (similar to Javadoc). Set to NO to disable this. +# The default value is: YES. + +BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES + +# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the brief +# description of a member or function before the detailed description +# +# Note: If both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the +# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed. +# The default value is: YES. + +REPEAT_BRIEF = YES + +# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator that is +# used to form the text in various listings. Each string in this list, if found +# as the leading text of the brief description, will be stripped from the text +# and the result, after processing the whole list, is used as the annotated +# text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. If left blank, the +# following values are used ($name is automatically replaced with the name of +# the entity):The $name class, The $name widget, The $name file, is, provides, +# specifies, contains, represents, a, an and the. + +ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \ + "The $name widget" \ + "The $name file" \ + is \ + provides \ + specifies \ + contains \ + represents \ + a \ + an \ + the + +# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then +# doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief +# description. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO + +# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all +# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those +# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment +# operators of the base classes will not be shown. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO + +# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will prepend the full path +# before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set to NO the +# shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used +# The default value is: YES. + +FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES + +# The STRIP_FROM_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. +# Stripping is only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand +# part of the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. +# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the path to +# strip. +# +# Note that you can specify absolute paths here, but also relative paths, which +# will be relative from the directory where doxygen is started. +# This tag requires that the tag FULL_PATH_NAMES is set to YES. + +STRIP_FROM_PATH = + +# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of the +# path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells the reader which +# header file to include in order to use a class. If left blank only the name of +# the header file containing the class definition is used. Otherwise one should +# specify the list of include paths that are normally passed to the compiler +# using the -I flag. + +STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH = + +# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter (but +# less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems doesn't +# support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHORT_NAMES = YES + +# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the +# first line (until the first dot) of a Javadoc-style comment as the brief +# description. If set to NO, the Javadoc-style will behave just like regular Qt- +# style comments (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief +# description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then doxygen will interpret the first +# line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style comment as the brief description. If +# set to NO, the Qt-style will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus +# requiring an explicit \brief command for a brief description.) +# The default value is: NO. + +QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO + +# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make doxygen treat a +# multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// comments) as +# a brief description. This used to be the default behavior. The new default is +# to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed description. Set this +# tag to YES if you prefer the old behavior instead. +# +# Note that setting this tag to YES also means that rational rose comments are +# not recognized any more. +# The default value is: NO. + +MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO + +# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES then an undocumented member inherits the +# documentation from any documented member that it re-implements. +# The default value is: YES. + +INHERIT_DOCS = YES + +# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES then doxygen will produce a new +# page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will be part +# of the file/class/namespace that contains it. +# The default value is: NO. + +SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO + +# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. Doxygen +# uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 16, default value: 4. + +TAB_SIZE = 4 + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that act as commands in +# the documentation. An alias has the form: +# name=value +# For example adding +# "sideeffect=@par Side Effects:\n" +# will allow you to put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the +# documentation, which will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading +# "Side Effects:". You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert +# newlines. + +ALIASES = + +# This tag can be used to specify a number of word-keyword mappings (TCL only). +# A mapping has the form "name=value". For example adding "class=itcl::class" +# will allow you to use the command class in the itcl::class meaning. + +TCL_SUBST = + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C sources +# only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. For +# instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list of all +# members will be omitted, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java or +# Python sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored +# for that language. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, +# qualified scopes will look different, etc. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for Fortran. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO + +# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL +# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for VHDL. +# The default value is: NO. + +OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO + +# Doxygen selects the parser to use depending on the extension of the files it +# parses. With this tag you can assign which parser to use for a given +# extension. Doxygen has a built-in mapping, but you can override or extend it +# using this tag. The format is ext=language, where ext is a file extension, and +# language is one of the parsers supported by doxygen: IDL, Java, Javascript, +# C#, C, C++, D, PHP, Objective-C, Python, Fortran (fixed format Fortran: +# FortranFixed, free formatted Fortran: FortranFree, unknown formatted Fortran: +# Fortran. In the later case the parser tries to guess whether the code is fixed +# or free formatted code, this is the default for Fortran type files), VHDL. For +# instance to make doxygen treat .inc files as Fortran files (default is PHP), +# and .f files as C (default is Fortran), use: inc=Fortran f=C. +# +# Note: For files without extension you can use no_extension as a placeholder. +# +# Note that for custom extensions you also need to set FILE_PATTERNS otherwise +# the files are not read by doxygen. + +EXTENSION_MAPPING = + +# If the MARKDOWN_SUPPORT tag is enabled then doxygen pre-processes all comments +# according to the Markdown format, which allows for more readable +# documentation. See http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/ for details. +# The output of markdown processing is further processed by doxygen, so you can +# mix doxygen, HTML, and XML commands with Markdown formatting. Disable only in +# case of backward compatibilities issues. +# The default value is: YES. + +MARKDOWN_SUPPORT = NO + +# When enabled doxygen tries to link words that correspond to documented +# classes, or namespaces to their corresponding documentation. Such a link can +# be prevented in individual cases by putting a % sign in front of the word or +# globally by setting AUTOLINK_SUPPORT to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +AUTOLINK_SUPPORT = YES + +# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want +# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should set this +# tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and +# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); +# versus func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration +# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate. +# The default value is: NO. + +BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO + +# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to +# enable parsing support. +# The default value is: NO. + +CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO + +# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip (see: +# http://www.riverbankcomputing.co.uk/software/sip/intro) sources only. Doxygen +# will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public instead +# of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present. +# The default value is: NO. + +SIP_SUPPORT = NO + +# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate +# getter and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES will make +# doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the documentation. +# This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or setting a simple +# type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the methods anyway, you +# should set this option to NO. +# The default value is: YES. + +IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES + +# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC +# tag is set to YES then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first +# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default +# all members of a group must be documented explicitly. +# The default value is: NO. + +DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO + +# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES to allow class member groups of the same type +# (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a subgroup of that +# type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to NO to prevent +# subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using the +# \nosubgrouping command. +# The default value is: YES. + +SUBGROUPING = YES + +# When the INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes, structs and unions +# are shown inside the group in which they are included (e.g. using \ingroup) +# instead of on a separate page (for HTML and Man pages) or section (for LaTeX +# and RTF). +# +# Note that this feature does not work in combination with +# SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_GROUPED_CLASSES = NO + +# When the INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS tag is set to YES, structs, classes, and unions +# with only public data fields or simple typedef fields will be shown inline in +# the documentation of the scope in which they are defined (i.e. file, +# namespace, or group documentation), provided this scope is documented. If set +# to NO, structs, classes, and unions are shown on a separate page (for HTML and +# Man pages) or section (for LaTeX and RTF). +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SIMPLE_STRUCTS = NO + +# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT tag is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or +# enum is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So +# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct +# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, +# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically be +# useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound +# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name. +# The default value is: NO. + +TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO + +# The size of the symbol lookup cache can be set using LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE. This +# cache is used to resolve symbols given their name and scope. Since this can be +# an expensive process and often the same symbol appears multiple times in the +# code, doxygen keeps a cache of pre-resolved symbols. If the cache is too small +# doxygen will become slower. If the cache is too large, memory is wasted. The +# cache size is given by this formula: 2^(16+LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range +# is 0..9, the default is 0, corresponding to a cache size of 2^16=65536 +# symbols. At the end of a run doxygen will report the cache usage and suggest +# the optimal cache size from a speed point of view. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9, default value: 0. + +LOOKUP_CACHE_SIZE = 0 + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Build related configuration options +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES, doxygen will assume all entities in +# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. Private +# class members and static file members will be hidden unless the +# EXTRACT_PRIVATE respectively EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES. +# Note: This will also disable the warnings about undocumented members that are +# normally produced when WARNINGS is set to YES. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ALL = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES, all private members of a class will +# be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_PACKAGE tag is set to YES, all members with package or internal +# scope will be included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_PACKAGE = NO + +# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES, all static members of a file will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_STATIC = YES + +# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES, classes (and structs) defined +# locally in source files will be included in the documentation. If set to NO, +# only classes defined in header files are included. Does not have any effect +# for Java sources. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES + +# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. If set to YES, local methods, +# which are defined in the implementation section but not in the interface are +# included in the documentation. If set to NO, only methods in the interface are +# included. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO + +# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be +# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called +# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base name of +# the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default anonymous namespace +# are hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented members inside documented classes or files. If set to NO these +# members will be included in the various overviews, but no documentation +# section is generated. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO + +# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all +# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. If set +# to NO, these classes will be included in the various overviews. This option +# has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO + +# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide all friend +# (class|struct|union) declarations. If set to NO, these declarations will be +# included in the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO + +# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, doxygen will hide any +# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. If set to NO, these +# blocks will be appended to the function's detailed documentation block. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO + +# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation that is typed after a +# \internal command is included. If the tag is set to NO then the documentation +# will be excluded. Set it to YES to include the internal documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INTERNAL_DOCS = NO + +# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will only generate file +# names in lower-case letters. If set to YES, upper-case letters are also +# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ +# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows +# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO. +# The default value is: system dependent. + +CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO then doxygen will show members with +# their full class and namespace scopes in the documentation. If set to YES, the +# scope will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO + +# If the HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE tag is set to NO (default) then doxygen will +# append additional text to a page's title, such as Class Reference. If set to +# YES the compound reference will be hidden. +# The default value is: NO. + +HIDE_COMPOUND_REFERENCE= NO + +# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES then doxygen will put a list of +# the files that are included by a file in the documentation of that file. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES + +# If the SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC tag is set to YES then Doxygen will add for each +# grouped member an include statement to the documentation, telling the reader +# which file to include in order to use the member. +# The default value is: NO. + +SHOW_GROUPED_MEMB_INC = NO + +# If the FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES tag is set to YES then doxygen will list include +# files with double quotes in the documentation rather than with sharp brackets. +# The default value is: NO. + +FORCE_LOCAL_INCLUDES = NO + +# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES then a tag [inline] is inserted in the +# documentation for inline members. +# The default value is: YES. + +INLINE_INFO = YES + +# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (detailed) documentation of file and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. +# The default value is: YES. + +SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES + +# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the brief +# descriptions of file, namespace and class members alphabetically by member +# name. If set to NO, the members will appear in declaration order. Note that +# this will also influence the order of the classes in the class list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO + +# If the SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the +# (brief and detailed) documentation of class members so that constructors and +# destructors are listed first. If set to NO the constructors will appear in the +# respective orders defined by SORT_BRIEF_DOCS and SORT_MEMBER_DOCS. +# Note: If SORT_BRIEF_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting brief +# member documentation. +# Note: If SORT_MEMBER_DOCS is set to NO this option is ignored for sorting +# detailed member documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_MEMBERS_CTORS_1ST = NO + +# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the hierarchy +# of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO the group names will +# appear in their defined order. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO + +# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be sorted by +# fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to NO, the class list will +# be sorted only by class name, not including the namespace part. +# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES. +# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the alphabetical +# list. +# The default value is: NO. + +SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO + +# If the STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING option is enabled and doxygen fails to do proper +# type resolution of all parameters of a function it will reject a match between +# the prototype and the implementation of a member function even if there is +# only one candidate or it is obvious which candidate to choose by doing a +# simple string match. By disabling STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING doxygen will still +# accept a match between prototype and implementation in such cases. +# The default value is: NO. + +STRICT_PROTO_MATCHING = NO + +# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the todo +# list. This list is created by putting \todo commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the test +# list. This list is created by putting \test commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) the bug +# list. This list is created by putting \bug commands in the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO + +# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or disable (NO) +# the deprecated list. This list is created by putting \deprecated commands in +# the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES + +# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional documentation +# sections, marked by \if <section_label> ... \endif and \cond <section_label> +# ... \endcond blocks. + +ENABLED_SECTIONS = + +# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines that the +# initial value of a variable or macro / define can have for it to appear in the +# documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified here +# it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. The +# appearance of the value of individual variables and macros / defines can be +# controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer command in the +# documentation regardless of this setting. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 30. + +MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30 + +# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated at +# the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES, the +# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_USED_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page. This +# will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the Folder Tree View +# (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_FILES = YES + +# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Namespaces +# page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index and from the +# Folder Tree View (if specified). +# The default value is: YES. + +SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES + +# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that +# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from +# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via +# popen()) the command command input-file, where command is the value of the +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and input-file is the name of an input file provided +# by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output is used as the file +# version. For an example see the documentation. + +FILE_VERSION_FILTER = + +# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed +# by doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated +# output files in an output format independent way. To create the layout file +# that represents doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can +# optionally specify a file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml +# will be used as the name of the layout file. +# +# Note that if you run doxygen from a directory containing a file called +# DoxygenLayout.xml, doxygen will parse it automatically even if the LAYOUT_FILE +# tag is left empty. + +LAYOUT_FILE = + +# The CITE_BIB_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more bib files containing +# the reference definitions. This must be a list of .bib files. The .bib +# extension is automatically appended if omitted. This requires the bibtex tool +# to be installed. See also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX for more info. +# For LaTeX the style of the bibliography can be controlled using +# LATEX_BIB_STYLE. To use this feature you need bibtex and perl available in the +# search path. See also \cite for info how to create references. + +CITE_BIB_FILES = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to warning and progress messages +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated to +# standard output by doxygen. If QUIET is set to YES this implies that the +# messages are off. +# The default value is: NO. + +QUIET = YES + +# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are +# generated to standard error (stderr) by doxygen. If WARNINGS is set to YES +# this implies that the warnings are on. +# +# Tip: Turn warnings on while writing the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARNINGS = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate +# warnings for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag +# will automatically be disabled. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES + +# If the WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for +# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some parameters +# in a documented function, or documenting parameters that don't exist or using +# markup commands wrongly. +# The default value is: YES. + +WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES + +# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be enabled to get warnings for functions that +# are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters or return +# value. If set to NO, doxygen will only warn about wrong or incomplete +# parameter documentation, but not about the absence of documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES + +# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that doxygen +# can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text tags, which +# will be replaced by the file and line number from which the warning originated +# and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain $version, which will +# be replaced by the version of the file (if it could be obtained via +# FILE_VERSION_FILTER) +# The default value is: $file:$line: $text. + +WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text" + +# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning and error +# messages should be written. If left blank the output is written to standard +# error (stderr). + +WARN_LOGFILE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the input files +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The INPUT tag is used to specify the files and/or directories that contain +# documented source files. You may enter file names like myfile.cpp or +# directories like /usr/src/myproject. Separate the files or directories with +# spaces. +# Note: If this tag is empty the current directory is searched. + +INPUT = ./ + +# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files +# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding. Doxygen uses +# libiconv (or the iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See the libiconv +# documentation (see: http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv) for the list of +# possible encodings. +# The default value is: UTF-8. + +INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8 + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank the +# following patterns are tested:*.c, *.cc, *.cxx, *.cpp, *.c++, *.java, *.ii, +# *.ixx, *.ipp, *.i++, *.inl, *.idl, *.ddl, *.odl, *.h, *.hh, *.hxx, *.hpp, +# *.h++, *.cs, *.d, *.php, *.php4, *.php5, *.phtml, *.inc, *.m, *.markdown, +# *.md, *.mm, *.dox, *.py, *.f90, *.f, *.for, *.tcl, *.vhd, *.vhdl, *.ucf, +# *.qsf, *.as and *.js. + +FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \ + *.c \ + *.txt + +# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to specify whether or not subdirectories should +# be searched for input files as well. +# The default value is: NO. + +RECURSIVE = YES + +# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should be +# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a +# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag. +# +# Note that relative paths are relative to the directory from which doxygen is +# run. + +EXCLUDE = Documentation/ + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used to select whether or not files or +# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix file system feature) are excluded +# from the input. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO + +# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude +# certain files from those directories. +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories for example use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = + +# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names +# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the +# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the +# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, +# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test +# +# Note that the wildcards are matched against the file with absolute path, so to +# exclude all test directories use the pattern */test/* + +EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __* \ + INCLUDE_FROM_* + +# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain example code fragments that are included (see the \include +# command). + +EXAMPLE_PATH = + +# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the +# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp and +# *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left blank all +# files are included. + +EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = * + +# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be +# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude commands +# irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. +# The default value is: NO. + +EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO + +# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or directories +# that contain images that are to be included in the documentation (see the +# \image command). + +IMAGE_PATH = + +# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should +# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program +# by executing (via popen()) the command: +# +# <filter> <input-file> +# +# where <filter> is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the +# name of an input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter +# program writes to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag +# will be ignored. +# +# Note that the filter must not add or remove lines; it is applied before the +# code is scanned, but not when the output code is generated. If lines are added +# or removed, the anchors will not be placed correctly. + +INPUT_FILTER = + +# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern +# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the +# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form: pattern=filter +# (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further information on how +# filters are used. If the FILTER_PATTERNS tag is empty or if none of the +# patterns match the file name, INPUT_FILTER is applied. + +FILTER_PATTERNS = + +# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using +# INPUT_FILTER) will also be used to filter the input files that are used for +# producing the source files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES). +# The default value is: NO. + +FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO + +# The FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify source filters per file +# pattern. A pattern will override the setting for FILTER_PATTERN (if any) and +# it is also possible to disable source filtering for a specific pattern using +# *.ext= (so without naming a filter). +# This tag requires that the tag FILTER_SOURCE_FILES is set to YES. + +FILTER_SOURCE_PATTERNS = + +# If the USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE tag refers to the name of a markdown file that +# is part of the input, its contents will be placed on the main page +# (index.html). This can be useful if you have a project on for instance GitHub +# and want to reuse the introduction page also for the doxygen output. + +USE_MDFILE_AS_MAINPAGE = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to source browsing +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will be +# generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. +# +# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure that +# also VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO. +# The default value is: NO. + +SOURCE_BROWSER = NO + +# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body of functions, +# classes and enums directly into the documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +INLINE_SOURCES = NO + +# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES will instruct doxygen to hide any +# special comment blocks from generated source code fragments. Normal C, C++ and +# Fortran comments will always remain visible. +# The default value is: YES. + +STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES + +# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented +# function all documented functions referencing it will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES then for each documented function +# all documented entities called/used by that function will be listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +REFERENCES_RELATION = NO + +# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set +# to YES then the hyperlinks from functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and +# REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will link to the source code. Otherwise they will +# link to the documentation. +# The default value is: YES. + +REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO + +# If SOURCE_TOOLTIPS is enabled (the default) then hovering a hyperlink in the +# source code will show a tooltip with additional information such as prototype, +# brief description and links to the definition and documentation. Since this +# will make the HTML file larger and loading of large files a bit slower, you +# can opt to disable this feature. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +SOURCE_TOOLTIPS = YES + +# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code will +# point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen built-in +# source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source tagging system +# (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You will need version +# 4.8.6 or higher. +# +# To use it do the following: +# - Install the latest version of global +# - Enable SOURCE_BROWSER and USE_HTAGS in the config file +# - Make sure the INPUT points to the root of the source tree +# - Run doxygen as normal +# +# Doxygen will invoke htags (and that will in turn invoke gtags), so these +# tools must be available from the command line (i.e. in the search path). +# +# The result: instead of the source browser generated by doxygen, the links to +# source code will now point to the output of htags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES. + +USE_HTAGS = NO + +# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set the YES then doxygen will generate a +# verbatim copy of the header file for each class for which an include is +# specified. Set to NO to disable this. +# See also: Section \class. +# The default value is: YES. + +VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO + +# If the CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING tag is set to YES then doxygen will use the +# clang parser (see: http://clang.llvm.org/) for more accurate parsing at the +# cost of reduced performance. This can be particularly helpful with template +# rich C++ code for which doxygen's built-in parser lacks the necessary type +# information. +# Note: The availability of this option depends on whether or not doxygen was +# compiled with the --with-libclang option. +# The default value is: NO. + +CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING = NO + +# If clang assisted parsing is enabled you can provide the compiler with command +# line options that you would normally use when invoking the compiler. Note that +# the include paths will already be set by doxygen for the files and directories +# specified with INPUT and INCLUDE_PATH. +# This tag requires that the tag CLANG_ASSISTED_PARSING is set to YES. + +CLANG_OPTIONS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the alphabetical class index +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index of all +# compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project contains a lot of +# classes, structs, unions or interfaces. +# The default value is: YES. + +ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES + +# The COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns in +# which the alphabetical index list will be split. +# Minimum value: 1, maximum value: 20, default value: 5. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5 + +# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all classes will +# be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. The IGNORE_PREFIX tag +# can be used to specify a prefix (or a list of prefixes) that should be ignored +# while generating the index headers. +# This tag requires that the tag ALPHABETICAL_INDEX is set to YES. + +IGNORE_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the HTML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate HTML output +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_HTML = YES + +# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_OUTPUT = html + +# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for each +# generated HTML page (for example: .htm, .php, .asp). +# The default value is: .html. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html + +# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML header file for +# each generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a +# standard header. +# +# To get valid HTML the header file that includes any scripts and style sheets +# that doxygen needs, which is dependent on the configuration options used (e.g. +# the setting GENERATE_TREEVIEW). It is highly recommended to start with a +# default header using +# doxygen -w html new_header.html new_footer.html new_stylesheet.css +# YourConfigFile +# and then modify the file new_header.html. See also section "Doxygen usage" +# for information on how to generate the default header that doxygen normally +# uses. +# Note: The header is subject to change so you typically have to regenerate the +# default header when upgrading to a newer version of doxygen. For a description +# of the possible markers and block names see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_HEADER = + +# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a user-defined HTML footer for each +# generated HTML page. If the tag is left blank doxygen will generate a standard +# footer. See HTML_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default +# footer and what special commands can be used inside the footer. See also +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the default footer +# that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_FOOTER = + +# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading style +# sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to fine-tune the look of +# the HTML output. If left blank doxygen will generate a default style sheet. +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the style +# sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# Note: It is recommended to use HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET instead of this tag, as +# it is more robust and this tag (HTML_STYLESHEET) will in the future become +# obsolete. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# cascading style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets +# created by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. +# This is preferred over using HTML_STYLESHEET since it does not replace the +# standard style sheet and is therefore more robust against future updates. +# Doxygen will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). For an example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The HTML_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the HTML output directory. Note +# that these files will be copied to the base HTML output directory. Use the +# $relpath^ marker in the HTML_HEADER and/or HTML_FOOTER files to load these +# files. In the HTML_STYLESHEET file, use the file name only. Also note that the +# files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_EXTRA_FILES = + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE tag controls the color of the HTML output. Doxygen +# will adjust the colors in the style sheet and background images according to +# this color. Hue is specified as an angle on a colorwheel, see +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Hue for more information. For instance the value +# 0 represents red, 60 is yellow, 120 is green, 180 is cyan, 240 is blue, 300 +# purple, and 360 is red again. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 359, default value: 220. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_HUE = 220 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT tag controls the purity (or saturation) of the colors +# in the HTML output. For a value of 0 the output will use grayscales only. A +# value of 255 will produce the most vivid colors. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 255, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_SAT = 100 + +# The HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA tag controls the gamma correction applied to the +# luminance component of the colors in the HTML output. Values below 100 +# gradually make the output lighter, whereas values above 100 make the output +# darker. The value divided by 100 is the actual gamma applied, so 80 represents +# a gamma of 0.8, The value 220 represents a gamma of 2.2, and 100 does not +# change the gamma. +# Minimum value: 40, maximum value: 240, default value: 80. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_COLORSTYLE_GAMMA = 80 + +# If the HTML_TIMESTAMP tag is set to YES then the footer of each generated HTML +# page will contain the date and time when the page was generated. Setting this +# to NO can help when comparing the output of multiple runs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_TIMESTAMP = NO + +# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML +# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the +# page has loaded. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES + +# With HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES one can control the preferred number of entries +# shown in the various tree structured indices initially; the user can expand +# and collapse entries dynamically later on. Doxygen will expand the tree to +# such a level that at most the specified number of entries are visible (unless +# a fully collapsed tree already exceeds this amount). So setting the number of +# entries 1 will produce a full collapsed tree by default. 0 is a special value +# representing an infinite number of entries and will result in a full expanded +# tree by default. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 9999, default value: 100. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +HTML_INDEX_NUM_ENTRIES = 100 + +# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 integrated development +# environment (see: http://developer.apple.com/tools/xcode/), introduced with +# OSX 10.5 (Leopard). To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a +# Makefile in the HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in +# that directory and running make install will install the docset in +# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find it at +# startup. See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html +# for more information. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_DOCSET = NO + +# This tag determines the name of the docset feed. A documentation feed provides +# an umbrella under which multiple documentation sets from a single provider +# (such as a company or product suite) can be grouped. +# The default value is: Doxygen generated docs. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs" + +# This tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify the documentation +# set bundle. This should be a reverse domain-name style string, e.g. +# com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen will append .docset to the name. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID tag specifies a string that should uniquely identify +# the documentation publisher. This should be a reverse domain-name style +# string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet.documentation. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_ID = org.doxygen.Publisher + +# The DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME tag identifies the documentation publisher. +# The default value is: Publisher. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCSET is set to YES. + +DOCSET_PUBLISHER_NAME = Publisher + +# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES then doxygen generates three +# additional HTML index files: index.hhp, index.hhc, and index.hhk. The +# index.hhp is a project file that can be read by Microsoft's HTML Help Workshop +# (see: http://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=21138) on +# Windows. +# +# The HTML Help Workshop contains a compiler that can convert all HTML output +# generated by doxygen into a single compiled HTML file (.chm). Compiled HTML +# files are now used as the Windows 98 help format, and will replace the old +# Windows help format (.hlp) on all Windows platforms in the future. Compressed +# HTML files also contain an index, a table of contents, and you can search for +# words in the documentation. The HTML workshop also contains a viewer for +# compressed HTML files. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO + +# The CHM_FILE tag can be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm +# file. You can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be +# written to the html output directory. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_FILE = + +# The HHC_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location (absolute path +# including file name) of the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty, +# doxygen will try to run the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp. +# The file has to be specified with full path. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +HHC_LOCATION = + +# The GENERATE_CHI flag controls if a separate .chi index file is generated +# (YES) or that it should be included in the master .chm file (NO). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +GENERATE_CHI = NO + +# The CHM_INDEX_ENCODING is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) +# and project file content. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +CHM_INDEX_ENCODING = + +# The BINARY_TOC flag controls whether a binary table of contents is generated +# (YES) or a normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file. Furthermore it +# enables the Previous and Next buttons. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +BINARY_TOC = NO + +# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members to +# the table of contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTMLHELP is set to YES. + +TOC_EXPAND = YES + +# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and +# QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER are set, an additional index file will be generated that +# can be used as input for Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help +# (.qch) of the generated HTML documentation. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_QHP = NO + +# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can be used to specify +# the file name of the resulting .qch file. The path specified is relative to +# the HTML output folder. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QCH_FILE = + +# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt Help +# Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Namespace +# (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#namespace). +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project + +# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating Qt +# Help Project output. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Virtual +# Folders (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#virtual- +# folders). +# The default value is: doc. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc + +# If the QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME tag is set, it specifies the name of a custom +# filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_NAME = + +# The QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes of the +# custom filter to add. For more information please see Qt Help Project / Custom +# Filters (see: http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#custom- +# filters). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_CUST_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS tag specifies the list of the attributes this +# project's filter section matches. Qt Help Project / Filter Attributes (see: +# http://qt-project.org/doc/qt-4.8/qthelpproject.html#filter-attributes). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHP_SECT_FILTER_ATTRS = + +# The QHG_LOCATION tag can be used to specify the location of Qt's +# qhelpgenerator. If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the +# generated .qhp file. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_QHP is set to YES. + +QHG_LOCATION = + +# If the GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files will be +# generated, together with the HTML files, they form an Eclipse help plugin. To +# install this plugin and make it available under the help contents menu in +# Eclipse, the contents of the directory containing the HTML and XML files needs +# to be copied into the plugins directory of eclipse. The name of the directory +# within the plugins directory should be the same as the ECLIPSE_DOC_ID value. +# After copying Eclipse needs to be restarted before the help appears. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP = NO + +# A unique identifier for the Eclipse help plugin. When installing the plugin +# the directory name containing the HTML and XML files should also have this +# name. Each documentation set should have its own identifier. +# The default value is: org.doxygen.Project. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_ECLIPSEHELP is set to YES. + +ECLIPSE_DOC_ID = org.doxygen.Project + +# If you want full control over the layout of the generated HTML pages it might +# be necessary to disable the index and replace it with your own. The +# DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index (tabs) at top +# of each HTML page. A value of NO enables the index and the value YES disables +# it. Since the tabs in the index contain the same information as the navigation +# tree, you can set this option to YES if you also set GENERATE_TREEVIEW to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +DISABLE_INDEX = YES + +# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index +# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information. If the tag +# value is set to YES, a side panel will be generated containing a tree-like +# index structure (just like the one that is generated for HTML Help). For this +# to work a browser that supports JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required +# (i.e. any modern browser). Windows users are probably better off using the +# HTML help feature. Via custom style sheets (see HTML_EXTRA_STYLESHEET) one can +# further fine-tune the look of the index. As an example, the default style +# sheet generated by doxygen has an example that shows how to put an image at +# the root of the tree instead of the PROJECT_NAME. Since the tree basically has +# the same information as the tab index, you could consider setting +# DISABLE_INDEX to YES when enabling this option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES + +# The ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE tag can be used to set the number of enum values that +# doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation. +# +# Note that a value of 0 will completely suppress the enum values from appearing +# in the overview section. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 20, default value: 4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1 + +# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be used +# to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree is shown. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1500, default value: 250. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250 + +# If the EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW option is set to YES, doxygen will open links to +# external symbols imported via tag files in a separate window. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +EXT_LINKS_IN_WINDOW = NO + +# Use this tag to change the font size of LaTeX formulas included as images in +# the HTML documentation. When you change the font size after a successful +# doxygen run you need to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML +# output directory to force them to be regenerated. +# Minimum value: 8, maximum value: 50, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# Use the FORMULA_TRANPARENT tag to determine whether or not the images +# generated for formulas are transparent PNGs. Transparent PNGs are not +# supported properly for IE 6.0, but are supported on all modern browsers. +# +# Note that when changing this option you need to delete any form_*.png files in +# the HTML output directory before the changes have effect. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +FORMULA_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Enable the USE_MATHJAX option to render LaTeX formulas using MathJax (see +# http://www.mathjax.org) which uses client side Javascript for the rendering +# instead of using pre-rendered bitmaps. Use this if you do not have LaTeX +# installed or if you want to formulas look prettier in the HTML output. When +# enabled you may also need to install MathJax separately and configure the path +# to it using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +USE_MATHJAX = NO + +# When MathJax is enabled you can set the default output format to be used for +# the MathJax output. See the MathJax site (see: +# http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. +# Possible values are: HTML-CSS (which is slower, but has the best +# compatibility), NativeMML (i.e. MathML) and SVG. +# The default value is: HTML-CSS. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_FORMAT = HTML-CSS + +# When MathJax is enabled you need to specify the location relative to the HTML +# output directory using the MATHJAX_RELPATH option. The destination directory +# should contain the MathJax.js script. For instance, if the mathjax directory +# is located at the same level as the HTML output directory, then +# MATHJAX_RELPATH should be ../mathjax. The default value points to the MathJax +# Content Delivery Network so you can quickly see the result without installing +# MathJax. However, it is strongly recommended to install a local copy of +# MathJax from http://www.mathjax.org before deployment. +# The default value is: http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_RELPATH = http://cdn.mathjax.org/mathjax/latest + +# The MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS tag can be used to specify one or more MathJax +# extension names that should be enabled during MathJax rendering. For example +# MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = TeX/AMSmath TeX/AMSsymbols +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_EXTENSIONS = + +# The MATHJAX_CODEFILE tag can be used to specify a file with javascript pieces +# of code that will be used on startup of the MathJax code. See the MathJax site +# (see: http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/output.html) for more details. For an +# example see the documentation. +# This tag requires that the tag USE_MATHJAX is set to YES. + +MATHJAX_CODEFILE = + +# When the SEARCHENGINE tag is enabled doxygen will generate a search box for +# the HTML output. The underlying search engine uses javascript and DHTML and +# should work on any modern browser. Note that when using HTML help +# (GENERATE_HTMLHELP), Qt help (GENERATE_QHP), or docsets (GENERATE_DOCSET) +# there is already a search function so this one should typically be disabled. +# For large projects the javascript based search engine can be slow, then +# enabling SERVER_BASED_SEARCH may provide a better solution. It is possible to +# search using the keyboard; to jump to the search box use <access key> + S +# (what the <access key> is depends on the OS and browser, but it is typically +# <CTRL>, <ALT>/<option>, or both). Inside the search box use the <cursor down +# key> to jump into the search results window, the results can be navigated +# using the <cursor keys>. Press <Enter> to select an item or <escape> to cancel +# the search. The filter options can be selected when the cursor is inside the +# search box by pressing <Shift>+<cursor down>. Also here use the <cursor keys> +# to select a filter and <Enter> or <escape> to activate or cancel the filter +# option. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_HTML is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE = NO + +# When the SERVER_BASED_SEARCH tag is enabled the search engine will be +# implemented using a web server instead of a web client using Javascript. There +# are two flavors of web server based searching depending on the EXTERNAL_SEARCH +# setting. When disabled, doxygen will generate a PHP script for searching and +# an index file used by the script. When EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled the indexing +# and searching needs to be provided by external tools. See the section +# "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SERVER_BASED_SEARCH = NO + +# When EXTERNAL_SEARCH tag is enabled doxygen will no longer generate the PHP +# script for searching. Instead the search results are written to an XML file +# which needs to be processed by an external indexer. Doxygen will invoke an +# external search engine pointed to by the SEARCHENGINE_URL option to obtain the +# search results. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). +# +# See the section "External Indexing and Searching" for details. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH = NO + +# The SEARCHENGINE_URL should point to a search engine hosted by a web server +# which will return the search results when EXTERNAL_SEARCH is enabled. +# +# Doxygen ships with an example indexer (doxyindexer) and search engine +# (doxysearch.cgi) which are based on the open source search engine library +# Xapian (see: http://xapian.org/). See the section "External Indexing and +# Searching" for details. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHENGINE_URL = + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the unindexed +# search data is written to a file for indexing by an external tool. With the +# SEARCHDATA_FILE tag the name of this file can be specified. +# The default file is: searchdata.xml. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +SEARCHDATA_FILE = searchdata.xml + +# When SERVER_BASED_SEARCH and EXTERNAL_SEARCH are both enabled the +# EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID tag can be used as an identifier for the project. This is +# useful in combination with EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS to search through multiple +# projects and redirect the results back to the right project. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID = + +# The EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS tag can be used to enable searching through doxygen +# projects other than the one defined by this configuration file, but that are +# all added to the same external search index. Each project needs to have a +# unique id set via EXTERNAL_SEARCH_ID. The search mapping then maps the id of +# to a relative location where the documentation can be found. The format is: +# EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = tagname1=loc1 tagname2=loc2 ... +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCHENGINE is set to YES. + +EXTRA_SEARCH_MAPPINGS = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the LaTeX output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate LaTeX output. +# The default value is: YES. + +GENERATE_LATEX = NO + +# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_OUTPUT = latex + +# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be +# invoked. +# +# Note that when enabling USE_PDFLATEX this option is only used for generating +# bitmaps for formulas in the HTML output, but not in the Makefile that is +# written to the output directory. +# The default file is: latex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex + +# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to generate +# index for LaTeX. +# The default file is: makeindex. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex + +# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact LaTeX +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +COMPACT_LATEX = NO + +# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used by the +# printer. +# Possible values are: a4 (210 x 297 mm), letter (8.5 x 11 inches), legal (8.5 x +# 14 inches) and executive (7.25 x 10.5 inches). +# The default value is: a4. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PAPER_TYPE = a4wide + +# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be used to specify one or more LaTeX package names +# that should be included in the LaTeX output. To get the times font for +# instance you can specify +# EXTRA_PACKAGES=times +# If left blank no extra packages will be included. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +EXTRA_PACKAGES = + +# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for the +# generated LaTeX document. The header should contain everything until the first +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard header. See +# section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to let doxygen write the +# default header to a separate file. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined header if you know what you are doing! The +# following commands have a special meaning inside the header: $title, +# $datetime, $date, $doxygenversion, $projectname, $projectnumber, +# $projectbrief, $projectlogo. Doxygen will replace $title with the empty +# string, for the replacement values of the other commands the user is referred +# to HTML_HEADER. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HEADER = + +# The LATEX_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX footer for the +# generated LaTeX document. The footer should contain everything after the last +# chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a standard footer. See +# LATEX_HEADER for more information on how to generate a default footer and what +# special commands can be used inside the footer. +# +# Note: Only use a user-defined footer if you know what you are doing! +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_FOOTER = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify additional user-defined +# LaTeX style sheets that are included after the standard style sheets created +# by doxygen. Using this option one can overrule certain style aspects. Doxygen +# will copy the style sheet files to the output directory. +# Note: The order of the extra style sheet files is of importance (e.g. the last +# style sheet in the list overrules the setting of the previous ones in the +# list). +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_STYLESHEET = + +# The LATEX_EXTRA_FILES tag can be used to specify one or more extra images or +# other source files which should be copied to the LATEX_OUTPUT output +# directory. Note that the files will be copied as-is; there are no commands or +# markers available. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_EXTRA_FILES = + +# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated is +# prepared for conversion to PDF (using ps2pdf or pdflatex). The PDF file will +# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. This +# makes the output suitable for online browsing using a PDF viewer. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES + +# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will use pdflatex to generate +# the PDF file directly from the LaTeX files. Set this option to YES, to get a +# higher quality PDF documentation. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +USE_PDFLATEX = YES + +# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \batchmode +# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep running +# if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. This option is also used +# when generating formulas in HTML. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO + +# If the LATEX_HIDE_INDICES tag is set to YES then doxygen will not include the +# index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) in the output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO + +# If the LATEX_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source +# code with syntax highlighting in the LaTeX output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +# The LATEX_BIB_STYLE tag can be used to specify the style to use for the +# bibliography, e.g. plainnat, or ieeetr. See +# http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/BibTeX and \cite for more info. +# The default value is: plain. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_LATEX is set to YES. + +LATEX_BIB_STYLE = plain + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the RTF output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate RTF output. The +# RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look too pretty with other RTF +# readers/editors. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_RTF = NO + +# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: rtf. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_OUTPUT = rtf + +# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES, doxygen generates more compact RTF +# documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to save some +# trees in general. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +COMPACT_RTF = NO + +# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated will +# contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will contain links (just like the HTML +# output) instead of page references. This makes the output suitable for online +# browsing using Word or some other Word compatible readers that support those +# fields. +# +# Note: WordPad (write) and others do not support links. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO + +# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's config +# file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide replacements, +# missing definitions are set to their default value. +# +# See also section "Doxygen usage" for information on how to generate the +# default style sheet that doxygen normally uses. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE = + +# Set optional variables used in the generation of an RTF document. Syntax is +# similar to doxygen's config file. A template extensions file can be generated +# using doxygen -e rtf extensionFile. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE = + +# If the RTF_SOURCE_CODE tag is set to YES then doxygen will include source code +# with syntax highlighting in the RTF output. +# +# Note that which sources are shown also depends on other settings such as +# SOURCE_BROWSER. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_RTF is set to YES. + +RTF_SOURCE_CODE = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the man page output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate man pages for +# classes and files. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_MAN = NO + +# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. A directory man3 will be created inside the directory specified by +# MAN_OUTPUT. +# The default directory is: man. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_OUTPUT = man + +# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to the generated +# man pages. In case the manual section does not start with a number, the number +# 3 is prepended. The dot (.) at the beginning of the MAN_EXTENSION tag is +# optional. +# The default value is: .3. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_EXTENSION = .3 + +# The MAN_SUBDIR tag determines the name of the directory created within +# MAN_OUTPUT in which the man pages are placed. If defaults to man followed by +# MAN_EXTENSION with the initial . removed. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_SUBDIR = + +# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and doxygen generates man output, then it +# will generate one additional man file for each entity documented in the real +# man page(s). These additional files only source the real man page, but without +# them the man command would be unable to find the correct page. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_MAN is set to YES. + +MAN_LINKS = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the XML output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an XML file that +# captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_XML = NO + +# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. If a +# relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in front of +# it. +# The default directory is: xml. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_OUTPUT = xml + +# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will dump the program +# listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing information) to +# the XML output. Note that enabling this will significantly increase the size +# of the XML output. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_XML is set to YES. + +XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the DOCBOOK output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_DOCBOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate Docbook files +# that can be used to generate PDF. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_DOCBOOK = NO + +# The DOCBOOK_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the Docbook pages will be put. +# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be put in +# front of it. +# The default directory is: docbook. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_OUTPUT = docbook + +# If the DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES, doxygen will include the +# program listings (including syntax highlighting and cross-referencing +# information) to the DOCBOOK output. Note that enabling this will significantly +# increase the size of the DOCBOOK output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_DOCBOOK is set to YES. + +DOCBOOK_PROGRAMLISTING = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate an +# AutoGen Definitions (see http://autogen.sf.net) file that captures the +# structure of the code including all documentation. Note that this feature is +# still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the Perl module output +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a Perl module +# file that captures the structure of the code including all documentation. +# +# Note that this feature is still experimental and incomplete at the moment. +# The default value is: NO. + +GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate the necessary +# Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able to generate PDF and DVI +# output from the Perl module output. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_LATEX = NO + +# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES, the Perl module output will be nicely +# formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful if you want to +# understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this tag is set to NO, the +# size of the Perl module output will be much smaller and Perl will parse it +# just the same. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES + +# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file are +# prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. This is useful +# so different doxyrules.make files included by the same Makefile don't +# overwrite each other's variables. +# This tag requires that the tag GENERATE_PERLMOD is set to YES. + +PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the preprocessor +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES, doxygen will evaluate all +# C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include files. +# The default value is: YES. + +ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES, doxygen will expand all macro names +# in the source code. If set to NO, only conditional compilation will be +# performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled way by setting +# EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +MACRO_EXPANSION = YES + +# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES then +# the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the PREDEFINED and +# EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES + +# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES, the include files in the +# INCLUDE_PATH will be searched if a #include is found. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES + +# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by the +# preprocessor. +# This tag requires that the tag SEARCH_INCLUDES is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_PATH = + +# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard +# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the +# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will be +# used. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS = + +# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that are +# defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of e.g. +# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name or +# name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the "=" are omitted, "=1" +# is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being undefined via #undef or +# recursively expanded use the := operator instead of the = operator. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__ \ + PROGMEM + +# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then this +# tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. The +# macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. Use the PREDEFINED +# tag if you want to use a different macro definition that overrules the +# definition found in the source code. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = + +# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES then doxygen's preprocessor will +# remove all references to function-like macros that are alone on a line, have +# an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such function macros +# are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse the parser if not +# removed. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag ENABLE_PREPROCESSING is set to YES. + +SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to external references +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# The TAGFILES tag can be used to specify one or more tag files. For each tag +# file the location of the external documentation should be added. The format of +# a tag file without this location is as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... +# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: +# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... +# where loc1 and loc2 can be relative or absolute paths or URLs. See the +# section "Linking to external documentation" for more information about the use +# of tag files. +# Note: Each tag file must have a unique name (where the name does NOT include +# the path). If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen is +# run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here. + +TAGFILES = + +# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create a +# tag file that is based on the input files it reads. See section "Linking to +# external documentation" for more information about the usage of tag files. + +GENERATE_TAGFILE = + +# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES, all external class will be listed in +# the class index. If set to NO, only the inherited external classes will be +# listed. +# The default value is: NO. + +ALLEXTERNALS = NO + +# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES, all external groups will be listed +# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will be +# listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES + +# If the EXTERNAL_PAGES tag is set to YES, all external pages will be listed in +# the related pages index. If set to NO, only the current project's pages will +# be listed. +# The default value is: YES. + +EXTERNAL_PAGES = YES + +# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script +# interpreter (i.e. the result of 'which perl'). +# The default file (with absolute path) is: /usr/bin/perl. + +PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl + +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Configuration options related to the dot tool +#--------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate a class diagram +# (in HTML and LaTeX) for classes with base or super classes. Setting the tag to +# NO turns the diagrams off. Note that this option also works with HAVE_DOT +# disabled, but it is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more +# powerful graphs. +# The default value is: YES. + +CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO + +# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc +# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see: +# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/)) to produce the chart and insert it in the +# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where +# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the +# default search path. + +MSCGEN_PATH = + +# You can include diagrams made with dia in doxygen documentation. Doxygen will +# then run dia to produce the diagram and insert it in the documentation. The +# DIA_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where the dia binary resides. +# If left empty dia is assumed to be found in the default search path. + +DIA_PATH = + +# If set to YES the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide inheritance +# and usage relations if the target is undocumented or is not a class. +# The default value is: YES. + +HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES + +# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is +# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz (see: +# http://www.graphviz.org/), a graph visualization toolkit from AT&T and Lucent +# Bell Labs. The other options in this section have no effect if this option is +# set to NO +# The default value is: NO. + +HAVE_DOT = NO + +# The DOT_NUM_THREADS specifies the number of dot invocations doxygen is allowed +# to run in parallel. When set to 0 doxygen will base this on the number of +# processors available in the system. You can set it explicitly to a value +# larger than 0 to get control over the balance between CPU load and processing +# speed. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 32, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_NUM_THREADS = 0 + +# When you want a differently looking font in the dot files that doxygen +# generates you can specify the font name using DOT_FONTNAME. You need to make +# sure dot is able to find the font, which can be done by putting it in a +# standard location or by setting the DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by +# setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory containing the font. +# The default value is: Helvetica. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTNAME = + +# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size (in points) of the font of +# dot graphs. +# Minimum value: 4, maximum value: 24, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTSIZE = 10 + +# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the default font as specified with +# DOT_FONTNAME. If you specify a different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set +# the path where dot can find it using this tag. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_FONTPATH = + +# If the CLASS_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# each documented class showing the direct and indirect inheritance relations. +# Setting this tag to YES will force the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CLASS_GRAPH = NO + +# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a +# graph for each documented class showing the direct and indirect implementation +# dependencies (inheritance, containment, and class references variables) of the +# class with other documented classes. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GROUP_GRAPHS tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for +# groups, showing the direct groups dependencies. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GROUP_GRAPHS = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate inheritance and +# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling +# Language. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LOOK = NO + +# If the UML_LOOK tag is enabled, the fields and methods are shown inside the +# class node. If there are many fields or methods and many nodes the graph may +# become too big to be useful. The UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS threshold limits the +# number of items for each type to make the size more manageable. Set this to 0 +# for no limit. Note that the threshold may be exceeded by 50% before the limit +# is enforced. So when you set the threshold to 10, up to 15 fields may appear, +# but if the number exceeds 15, the total amount of fields shown is limited to +# 10. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 100, default value: 10. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +UML_LIMIT_NUM_FIELDS = 10 + +# If the TEMPLATE_RELATIONS tag is set to YES then the inheritance and +# collaboration graphs will show the relations between templates and their +# instances. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO + +# If the INCLUDE_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are set to +# YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing the +# direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO + +# If the INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, ENABLE_PREPROCESSING and SEARCH_INCLUDES tags are +# set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented file showing +# the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with other documented +# files. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALL_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a call +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callgraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALL_GRAPH = NO + +# If the CALLER_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will generate a caller +# dependency graph for every global function or class method. +# +# Note that enabling this option will significantly increase the time of a run. +# So in most cases it will be better to enable caller graphs for selected +# functions only using the \callergraph command. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +CALLER_GRAPH = NO + +# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY tag is set to YES then doxygen will graphical +# hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO + +# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH tag is set to YES then doxygen will show the +# dependencies a directory has on other directories in a graphical way. The +# dependency relations are determined by the #include relations between the +# files in the directories. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO + +# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images +# generated by dot. +# Note: If you choose svg you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order +# to make the SVG files visible in IE 9+ (other browsers do not have this +# requirement). +# Possible values are: png, jpg, gif and svg. +# The default value is: png. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png + +# If DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT is set to svg, then this option can be set to YES to +# enable generation of interactive SVG images that allow zooming and panning. +# +# Note that this requires a modern browser other than Internet Explorer. Tested +# and working are Firefox, Chrome, Safari, and Opera. +# Note: For IE 9+ you need to set HTML_FILE_EXTENSION to xhtml in order to make +# the SVG files visible. Older versions of IE do not have SVG support. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +INTERACTIVE_SVG = NO + +# The DOT_PATH tag can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be +# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_PATH = + +# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the \dotfile +# command). +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOTFILE_DIRS = + +# The MSCFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain msc files that are included in the documentation (see the \mscfile +# command). + +MSCFILE_DIRS = + +# The DIAFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that +# contain dia files that are included in the documentation (see the \diafile +# command). + +DIAFILE_DIRS = + +# When using plantuml, the PLANTUML_JAR_PATH tag should be used to specify the +# path where java can find the plantuml.jar file. If left blank, it is assumed +# PlantUML is not used or called during a preprocessing step. Doxygen will +# generate a warning when it encounters a \startuml command in this case and +# will not generate output for the diagram. + +PLANTUML_JAR_PATH = + +# When using plantuml, the specified paths are searched for files specified by +# the !include statement in a plantuml block. + +PLANTUML_INCLUDE_PATH = + +# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of nodes +# that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph becomes +# larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is visualized +# by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the number of direct +# children of the root node in a graph is already larger than +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note that +# the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 10000, default value: 50. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15 + +# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the graphs +# generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable from the +# root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes that lay +# further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this option to 1 +# or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large code bases. Also +# note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by +# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction. +# Minimum value: 0, maximum value: 1000, default value: 0. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2 + +# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent +# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not seem +# to support this out of the box. +# +# Warning: Depending on the platform used, enabling this option may lead to +# badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of a graph (i.e. they become hard to +# read). +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES + +# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES to allow dot to generate multiple output +# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This +# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) support +# this, this feature is disabled by default. +# The default value is: NO. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO + +# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES doxygen will generate a legend page +# explaining the meaning of the various boxes and arrows in the dot generated +# graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +GENERATE_LEGEND = YES + +# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES, doxygen will remove the intermediate dot +# files that are used to generate the various graphs. +# The default value is: YES. +# This tag requires that the tag HAVE_DOT is set to YES. + +DOT_CLEANUP = YES diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/makefile b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6c38917cb3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/XPLAINBridge/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,54 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# +# -------------------------------------- +# LUFA Project Makefile. +# -------------------------------------- + +# Run "make help" for target help. + +AVRISP_PATH = ../AVRISP-MKII + +MCU = at90usb1287 +ARCH = AVR8 +BOARD = XPLAIN +F_CPU = 8000000 +F_USB = $(F_CPU) +OPTIMIZATION = s +TARGET = XPLAINBridge +SRC = $(TARGET).c Lib/SoftUART.c USARTDescriptors.c $(AVRISP_PATH)/AVRISPDescriptors.c $(AVRISP_PATH)/Lib/V2Protocol.c \ + $(AVRISP_PATH)/Lib/V2ProtocolParams.c $(AVRISP_PATH)/Lib/ISP/ISPProtocol.c $(AVRISP_PATH)/Lib/ISP/ISPTarget.c \ + $(AVRISP_PATH)/Lib/XPROG/XPROGProtocol.c $(AVRISP_PATH)/Lib/XPROG/XPROGTarget.c $(AVRISP_PATH)/Lib/XPROG/XMEGANVM.c \ + $(AVRISP_PATH)/Lib/XPROG/TINYNVM.c $(LUFA_SRC_USB) $(LUFA_SRC_USBCLASS) +LUFA_PATH = ../../LUFA +CC_FLAGS = -DUSE_LUFA_CONFIG_HEADER -IConfig/ -I$(AVRISP_PATH) +LD_FLAGS = + +# Default target +all: + +# Since this project borrows files from the AVRISP-MKII project which may also have an +# identical OBJDIR directory, we need to enforce the use of this project's object file +# directory as the one where the build object files are to be stored, by giving it a +# path relative to the current folder. +OBJDIR := ./obj + +# Include LUFA-specific DMBS extension modules +DMBS_LUFA_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/LUFA +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-sources.mk +include $(DMBS_LUFA_PATH)/lufa-gcc.mk + +# Include common DMBS build system modules +DMBS_PATH ?= $(LUFA_PATH)/Build/DMBS/DMBS +include $(DMBS_PATH)/core.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/cppcheck.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/doxygen.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/dfu.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/gcc.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/hid.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/avrdude.mk +include $(DMBS_PATH)/atprogram.mk diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/makefile b/lib/lufa/Projects/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..1681584244 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,47 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +# Makefile to build all the LUFA Projects. Call with "make all" to +# rebuild all projects. + +# Projects are pre-cleaned before each one is built, to ensure any +# custom LUFA library build options are reflected in the compiled +# code. + +PROJECT_DIRECTORIES := $(shell ls -d */) + +# This makefile is potentially infinitely recursive if something really bad +# happens when determining the set of project directories - hard-abort if +# more than 10 levels deep to avoid angry emails. +ifeq ($(MAKELEVEL), 10) + $(error EMERGENCY ABORT: INFINITE RECURSION DETECTED) +endif + +# Need to special-case building without a per-project object directory +ifeq ($(OBJDIR),) + # If no target specified, force "clean all" and disallow parallel build + ifeq ($(MAKECMDGOALS),) + MAKECMDGOALS := clean all + .NOTPARALLEL: + endif + + # If one of the targets is to build, force "clean" beforehand and disallow parallel build + ifneq ($(findstring all, $(MAKECMDGOALS)),) + MAKECMDGOALS := clean $(MAKECMDGOALS) + .NOTPARALLEL: + endif +endif + +%: $(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES) + @echo . > /dev/null + +$(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES): + @$(MAKE) -C $@ $(MAKECMDGOALS) + +.PHONY: $(PROJECT_DIRECTORIES) + diff --git a/lib/lufa/README.txt b/lib/lufa/README.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..80a5c81d88 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/README.txt @@ -0,0 +1,56 @@ + + _ _ _ ___ _ + | | | | | __/ \ + | |_| U | _| o | - The Lightweight USB + |___|___|_||_n_| Framework for AVRs + ========================================= + Written by Dean Camera + dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com + + http://www.lufa-lib.org + ========================================= + + LUFA is donation supported. To support LUFA, + please donate at http://www.lufa-lib.org/donate + + Released under a modified MIT license - see + LUFA/License.txt for license details. + + For Commercial Licensing information, see + http://www.lufa-lib.org/license + + +This package contains the complete LUFA library, demos, user-submitted +projects and bootloaders for use with compatible microcontroller models. +LUFA is a simple to use, lightweight framework which sits atop the hardware +USB controller in specific AVR microcontroller models, and allows for the +quick and easy creation of complex USB devices and hosts. + +To get started, you will need to install the "Doxygen" documentation +generation tool. If you use Linux, this can be installed via the "doxygen" +package in your chosen package management tool - under Ubuntu, this can be +achieved by running the following command in the terminal: + + sudo apt-get install doxygen + +Other package managers and distributions will have similar methods to +install Doxygen. In Windows, you can download a prebuilt installer for +Doxygen from its website, www.doxygen.org. + +Once installed, you can then use the Doxygen tool to generate the library +documentation from the command line or terminal of your operating system. To +do this, open your terminal or command line to the root directory of the +LUFA package, and type the following command: + + make doxygen + +Which will recursively generate documentation for all elements in the +library - the core, plus all demos, projects and bootloaders. Generated +documentation will then be available by opening the file "index.html" of the +created Documentation/html/ subdirectories inside each project folder. + +The documentation for the library itself (but not the documentation for the +individual demos, projects or bootloaders) is also available as a separate +package from the project webpage for convenience if Doxygen cannot be +installed. + diff --git a/lib/lufa/makefile b/lib/lufa/makefile new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..56d40086c4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/makefile @@ -0,0 +1,26 @@ +# +# LUFA Library +# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. +# +# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +# www.lufa-lib.org +# + +# Makefile to build the LUFA library, projects and demos. + +# Call with "make all" to rebuild everything, "make clean" to clean everything, +# "make mostlyclean" to remove all intermediary files but preserve any binaries, +# "make doxygen" to document everything with Doxygen (if installed). Call +# "make help" for additional target build information within a specific project. + +all: + +%: + @echo Executing \"make $@\" on all LUFA library elements. + @echo + $(MAKE) -C LUFA $@ + $(MAKE) -C Demos $@ + $(MAKE) -C Projects $@ + $(MAKE) -C Bootloaders $@ + @echo + @echo LUFA \"make $@\" operation complete. |